This is a modern-English version of Principles of Geology: or, The Modern Changes of the Earth and its Inhabitants Considered as Illustrative of Geology, originally written by Lyell, Charles, Sir. It has been thoroughly updated, including changes to sentence structure, words, spelling, and grammar—to ensure clarity for contemporary readers, while preserving the original spirit and nuance. If you click on a paragraph, you will see the original text that we modified, and you can toggle between the two versions.

Scroll to the bottom of this page and you will find a free ePUB download link for this book.


Transcribers note:
There are a very large number of words in the text which occur joined, hyphenated and separated with similar frequencies. No attempt has been made to assure consistency as this would mean revising the whole book.

PRINCIPLES

OF

GEOLOGY.

VIEW OF THE TEMPLE OF SERAPIS AT PUZZUOLI IN 1836

VIEW OF THE TEMPLE OF SERAPIS AT PUZZUOLI IN 1836.


VIEW OF THE TEMPLE OF SERAPIS AT PUZZUOLI IN 1836.


PRINCIPLES

OF

GEOLOGY.

OR,

THE MODERN CHANGES OF THE EARTH AND ITS INHABITANTS

CONSIDERED AS ILLUSTRATIVE OF GEOLOGY.

BY

SIR CHARLES LYELL, M.A. F.R.S.

VICE-PRESIDENT OF THE GEOLOGICAL SOCIETY OF LONDON; AUTHOR OF "A MANUAL OF
ELEMENTARY GEOLOGY," "TRAVELS IN NORTH AMERICA," "A SECOND
VISIT TO THE UNITED STATES," ETC. ETC.

VICE-PRESIDENT OF THE GEOLOGICAL SOCIETY OF LONDON; AUTHOR OF "A MANUAL OF
ELEMENTARY GEOLOGY," "TRAVELS IN NORTH AMERICA," "A SECOND
VISIT TO THE UNITED STATES," AND MORE.

NEW AND ENTIRELY REVISED EDITION.

ILLUSTRATED WITH MAPS, PLATES, AND WOODCUTS.

NEW YORK:
D. APPLETON & CO., 346 & 348 BROADWAY.
M.DCCC.LIV.


"Verè scire est per causas scire."—Bacon.

"To truly know is to know the causes."—Bacon.

"The stony rocks are not primeval, but the daughters of Time."—Linnæus, Syst. Nat. ed. 5, Stockholm, 1748, p. 219.

"The rocky stones aren’t ancient, but creations of Time."—Linnaeus, Syst. Nat. ed. 5, Stockholm, 1748, p. 219.

"Amid all the revolutions of the globe, the economy of nature has been uniform, and her laws are the only things that have resisted the general movement. The rivers and the rocks, the seas and the continents have been changed in all their parts; but the laws which direct those changes, and the rules to which they are subject, have remained invariably the same."—Playfair, Illustrations of the Huttonian Theory, § 374.

"Throughout all the changes on Earth, the natural order has remained consistent, and its laws are the only things that have withstood the overall changes. The rivers and mountains, the oceans and landmasses have transformed in every aspect; however, the laws that govern those changes and the principles they follow have stayed exactly the same."—Playfair, Illustrations of the Huttonian Theory, § 374.

"The inhabitants of the globe, like all the other parts of it, are subject to change. It is not only the individual that perishes, but whole species.

"The people of the world, like everything else in it, are always changing. It's not just individuals that die, but entire species."

"A change in the animal kingdom seems to be a part of the order of Nature, and is visible in instances to which human power cannot have extended."—Playfair, Illustrations of the Huttonian Theory, § 413.

"A change in the animal kingdom appears to be a natural occurrence and can be seen in situations beyond human control."—Playfair, Illustrations of the Huttonian Theory, § 413.


PREFACE TO THE NINTH EDITION.

The Principles of Geology in the first five editions embraced not only a view of the modern changes of the earth and its inhabitants, as set forth in the present work, but also some account of those monuments of analogous changes of ancient date, both in the organic and inorganic world, which it is the business of the geologist to interpret. The subject last mentioned, or "geology proper," constituted originally a fourth book, now omitted, the same having been enlarged into a separate treatise, first published in 1838, in one volume 12mo., and called "The Elements of Geology," afterwards recast in two volumes 12mo. in 1842, and again re-edited under the title of "Manual of Elementary Geology," in one volume 8vo.in 1851. The "Principles" and "Manual" thus divided, occupy, with one exception, to which I shall presently allude, very different ground. The "Principles" treat of such portions of the economy of existing nature, animate and inanimate, as are illustrative of Geology, so as to comprise an investigation of the permanent effects of causes now in action, which may serve as records to after ages of the present condition of the globe and its inhabitants. Such effects are the enduring monuments of the ever-varying state of the physical geography of the globe, the lasting signs of its destruction and renovation, and the memorials of the equally fluctuating condition of the organic world. They may be regarded, in short, as a symbolical language, in which the earth's autobiography is written.

The first five editions of the Principles of Geology covered not just a look at the modern changes of the Earth and its inhabitants, as discussed in this work, but also a description of those signs of similar changes from ancient times, both in living and non-living things, which geologists aim to interpret. The latter topic, referred to as "geology proper," originally formed a fourth book, which has now been removed and expanded into a separate work, first published in 1838 as a single volume 12mo and titled "The Elements of Geology," later revised into two volumes 12mo in 1842, and then re-edited under the title "Manual of Elementary Geology" in one volume 8vo in 1851. The "Principles" and "Manual" thus operate in largely different areas, with one exception that I will mention shortly. The "Principles" focus on aspects of the current natural world, both living and non-living, that illustrate geology. This includes examining the lasting impacts of ongoing processes that may serve as records for future generations about the current state of the Earth and its inhabitants. These effects represent enduring signs of the constantly changing physical geography of the planet, the lasting indicators of its destruction and renewal, and the reminders of the equally shifting situation of the organic world. In summary, they can be seen as a symbolic language in which the Earth’s autobiography is recorded.

In the "Manual of Elementary Geology," on the other hand, I have treated briefly of the component materials of the earth's crust, their arrangement and relative position, and their organic contents, which, when deciphered by aid of the key supplied vi by the study of the modern changes above alluded to, reveal to us the annals of a grand succession of past events—a series of revolutions which the solid exterior of the globe, and its living inhabitants, have experienced in times antecedent to the creation of man.

In the "Manual of Elementary Geology," I have briefly discussed the materials that make up the earth's crust, their arrangement and relative positions, and their organic contents. When interpreted using the key provided vi by studying the modern changes mentioned earlier, these reveal a record of significant past events—a series of changes that the solid surface of the planet and its living beings have gone through long before the existence of humans.

In thus separating the two works, however, I have retained in the "Principles" (book i.) the discussion of some matters which might fairly be regarded as common to both treatises; as for example, an historical sketch of the early progress of geology, followed by a series of preliminary essays to explain the facts and arguments which lead me to believe that the forces now operating upon and beneath the earth's surface may be the same, both in kind and degree, as those which at remote epochs have worked out geological changes. (See Analysis of Contents of this work, p. ix.)

In separating these two works, I have kept in the "Principles" (book i.) the discussion of some topics that can reasonably be considered relevant to both texts; for instance, a historical overview of the early development of geology, followed by a series of introductory essays to clarify the facts and arguments that lead me to believe that the forces currently acting on and beneath the earth's surface may be the same, in both type and intensity, as those that have caused geological changes in distant past epochs. (See Analysis of Contents of this work, p. ix.)

If I am asked whether the "Principles" or the "Manual" should be studied first, I feel much the same difficulty in answering the question as if a student should inquire whether he ought to take up first a treatise on Chemistry, or one on Natural Philosophy, subjects sufficiently distinct, yet inseparably connected. On the whole, while I have endeavored to make each of the two treatises, in their present form, quite independent of the other, I would recommend the reader to study first the modern changes of the earth and its inhabitants as they are discussed in the present volume, proceeding afterwards to the classification and interpretation of the monuments of more remote ages.

If I'm asked whether to study the "Principles" or the "Manual" first, I find it as challenging to answer as if a student were to ask whether they should dive into a book on Chemistry or one on Natural Philosophy—two subjects that are clearly different but closely related. Overall, while I've tried to make each of these two texts fairly independent from the other, I would suggest that readers start with the modern changes of the Earth and its inhabitants as covered in this volume, and then move on to the classification and interpretation of the monuments from earlier periods.

Charles Lyell.

Charles Lyell.

11 Harley Street, London, May 24, 1853.

11 Harley Street, London, May 24, 1853.


Dates of the successive Editions of the "Principles" and "Elements" (or Manual) of Geology, by the Author.

Principles, 1st vol. in octvo, published in Jan. 1830.
—————, 2d vol. in octvo, published in Jan. 1832.
—————, 1st vol. 2d edition in octavo 1832.
—————, 2d vol. 2d edition in octavo Jan. 1833.
————— 3d vol. 1st edition in octavo May, 1833.

—————, New edition (called the 3d) of the whole work in 4 vols. 12mo

—————, New edition (called the 3rd) of the entire work in 4 vols. 12mo

May, 1834.
—————, 4th edition, 4 vols. 12mo June, 1835.
—————, 5th edition, 4 vols. 12mo Mar. 1837.
Elements, 1st edition in one vol July, 1838.
Principles, 6th edition, 3 vols. 12mo June, 1840.
Elements, 2d edition in 2 vols. 12mo July, 1841.
Principles, 7th edition in one vol. 8vo Feb. 1847.
—————, 8th edition in one vol. 8vo May, 1850.

Manual of Elementary Geology (or "Elements," 3d edition) in one vol. 8vo.

Manual of Elementary Geology (or "Elements," 3rd edition) in one volume, 8vo.

Jan. 1851.
Manual, 4th edition, one vol. 8vo Jan. 1852.
Principles, 9th edition, now published in one vol. 8vo June, 1853.

ANALYSIS OF THE CONTENTS

OF

THE PRINCIPLES OF GEOLOGY.


BOOK I. (Chapters 1 to 13.

historical sketch of the progress of geology, with a series of essays to show that the monuments of the ancient state of the earth and its inhabitants, which this science interprets, can only be understood by a previous acquaintance with terrestrial changes now in progress, both in the organic and inorganic worlds.

A historical overview of how geology has developed, along with a collection of essays that show that the remains of the Earth's ancient state and its inhabitants, which this science studies, can only be understood through prior knowledge of the ongoing changes taking place on Earth, both in the organic and inorganic realms.

CHAPTER I

Geology defined—Its relation to other Sciences

Geology defined—Its relationship to other Sciences

Page 1
CHAPTER II.

Oriental and Egyptian Cosmogonies—Doctrines of the Greeks and Romans bearing on Geology

Oriental and Egyptian Creation Myths—Greek and Roman Theories Related to Geology

4
CHAPTER III.

Historical progress of Geology—Arabian Writers—Italian, French, German, and English geologists before the 19th century—Physico-theological school

Historical progress of Geology—Arabian Writers—Italian, French, German, and English geologists before the 19th century—Physico-theological school

17
CHAPTER IV.

Werner and Hutton—Modern progress of the science

Werner and Hutton—Modern Progress in Science

46
CHAPTER V.

Prepossessions in regard to the duration of past time, and other causes which have retarded the progress of Geology

Preconceptions about the length of past time, along with other factors that have slowed down the advancement of Geology

61
CHAPTER VI.

Agreement of the ancient and modern course of nature considered—Changes of climate

Agreement of the ancient and modern course of nature considered—Changes in climate

73
CHAPTERS VII. VIII.

Causes of vicissitudes in climate, and their connection with changes in physical geography

Causes of changes in climate and their link to shifts in physical geography

92, 114
CHAPTER IX.

Theory of the progressive development of organic life at successive periods considered—Modern origin of Man

Theory of the progressive development of organic life during different periods—Modern origins of humanity

130
xCHAPTER X

Supposed intensity of aqueous forces at remote periods—Erratic blocks—Deluges

Supposed strength of water forces in ancient times—Random boulders—Floods

153
CHAPTER XI.

Supposed former intensity of the igneous forces—Upheaval of land—Volcanic action

Supposed past intensity of volcanic forces—Rising land—Volcanic activity

160
CHAPTER XII.

Causes of the difference in texture of older and newer rocks—Plutonic and Metamorphic. action

Causes of the difference in texture of older and newer rocks—Plutonic and Metamorphic. action

175
CHAPTER XIII.

Supposed alternate periods of repose and disorder—Opposite doctrine, which refers geological phenomena to an uninterrupted series of changes in the organic and inorganic world, unattended with general catastrophes, or the development of paroxysmal forces

Supposed alternate periods of rest and chaos—Opposite theory, which connects geological phenomena to a continuous series of changes in the organic and inorganic world, without general disasters, or the emergence of sudden forces.

180

BOOK II. (Chapters XIV. to XXXII.)

observed changes in the inorganic world now in progress: first, the effects of aqueous causes, such as rivers, springs, glaciers, waves, tides, and currents; secondly, of igneous causes, or subterranean heat, as exhibited in the volcano and the earthquake.

Noted changes in the inorganic world that are happening right now include: first, the effects of water-related factors such as rivers, springs, glaciers, waves, tides, and currents; second, the impacts of volcanic activity and underground heat, as observed in volcanoes and earthquakes.

CHAPTER XIV.

Aqueous causes—Excavating and transporting power of rivers

Aqueous causes—The excavating and transporting power of rivers

198
CHAPTER XV

Carrying power of river-ice—Glaciers and Icebergs

Carrying capacity of river ice—Glaciers and Icebergs

219
CHAPTER XVI.

Phenomena of springs

Spring phenomena

232
CHAPTER XVII

Reproductive effects of rivers—Deltas of lakes and inland seas

Reproductive effects of rivers—Deltas of lakes and inland seas

251
CHAPTER XVIII.

Deltas of the Mississippi, Ganges, and other rivers exposed to tidal action

Deltas of the Mississippi, Ganges, and other rivers subject to tidal influence

263
CHAPTERS XIX. XX. XXI.

Denuding, transporting, and depositing agency of the waves, tides, and currents—Waste of sea-cliffs on the coast of England—Delta of the Rhine—Deposition of sediment under the influence of marine currents

Denuding, transporting, and depositing actions of the waves, tides, and currents—Erosion of sea cliffs along the coast of England—Delta of the Rhine—Sediment deposition influenced by marine currents

290, 321, 337
CHAPTER XXII.

Observed effects of igneous causes—Regions of active volcanoes

Observed effects of volcanic activity—Areas with active volcanoes

344
CHAPTERS XXIII. XXIV.

History of the volcanic eruptions of the district round Naples—Structure of Vesuvius—Herculaneum and Pompeii

History of the volcanic eruptions around Naples—Structure of Vesuvius—Herculaneum and Pompeii

360, 375
xiCHAPTER XXV.

Etna—Its eruptions—Structure and antiquity of the cone

Etna—Its eruptions—Structure and age of the cone

396
CHAPTER XXVI.

Volcanoes of Iceland, Mexico, the Canaries, and Grecian Archipelago—Mud volcanoes

Volcanoes of Iceland, Mexico, the Canary Islands, and the Greek Archipelago—Mud volcanoes

424
CHAPTER XXVII.

Earthquakes and the permanent changes attending them

Earthquakes and the lasting changes that come with them

451
CHAPTER XXVIII.

Earthquake of 1783 in Calabria

Calabria earthquake of 1783

471
CHAPTER XXIX.

Elevation and subsidence of dry land, and of the bed of the sea during earthquakes—Evidence of the same afforded by the Temple of Serapis near Naples

Elevation and sinking of dry land, and of the ocean floor during earthquakes—Evidence of this is provided by the Temple of Serapis near Naples.

493
CHAPTER XXX.

Elevation and subsidence of land in regions free from volcanoes and earthquakes—Rising of land in Sweden

Elevation and sinking of land in areas without volcanoes and earthquakes—Land rising in Sweden

519
CHAPTERS XXXI. XXXII.

Causes of earthquakes and volcanoes—Theory of central fluidity of the earth—Chemical theory of volcanoes—Causes of permanent upheaval and depression of land

Causes of earthquakes and volcanoes—Theory of the Earth's fluid core—Chemical theory of volcanoes—Reasons for permanent land uplift and sinking

533, 545

BOOK III. (Chapters XXXIII to L.)

observed changes of the organic world now in progress; first, nature and geographical distribution of species, and theories respecting their creation and extinction; secondly, the influence of organic beings in modifying physical geography; thirdly, the laws according to which they are imbedded in volcanic, freshwater, and marine deposits.

noted changes in the organic world that are happening right now; first, the nature and geographical distribution of species, along with theories about their creation and extinction; secondly, the impact of living organisms on changing physical geography; thirdly, the laws that dictate how they are found in volcanic, freshwater, and marine deposits.

CHAPTERS XXXIII. XXXIV. XXXV. XXXVI.

Whether species have a real existence in nature—Theory of transmutation of species—Variability of species—Phenomena of hybrids in animals and plants

Whether species actually exist in nature—Theory of species transformation—Variability of species—Hybrid phenomena in animals and plants

566, 578, 591, 600
CHAPTER XXXVII.

Laws which regulate the geographical distribution of species—Distinct provinces of peculiar species of plants—Their mode of diffusion

Laws that control where species are found—Different regions with unique plant species—How they spread

612
CHAPTER XXXVIII.

Distinct provinces of peculiar species of animals—Distribution and dispersion of quadrupeds, birds, and reptiles

Distinct regions with unique species of animals—Distribution and spread of mammals, birds, and reptiles

629
CHAPTER XXXIX.

Geographical distribution and migrations of fish—Of testacea—Of zoophytes—Of insects—Geographical distribution and diffusion of the human race

Geographical distribution and migrations of fish—Of testacea—Of zoophytes—Of insects—Geographical distribution and diffusion of the human race

646
CHAPTER XL.

Theories respecting the original introduction of species—Reciprocal influence of species on each other

Theories about how species were originally introduced—The mutual influence of species on one another

665
xiiCHAPTERS XLI. XLII.

Extinction of species—How every extension of the range of a species alters the condition of many others—Effect of changes of climate

Extinction of species—How every expansion of a species' range affects many others—Impact of climate change

677, 689
CHAPTER XLIII.

Creation of species—Whether the loss of certain animals and plants is compensated by the introduction of new species

Creation of species—Is the decline of certain animals and plants balanced out by the introduction of new species?

701
CHAPTER XLIV.

Modifications in physical geography caused by organic beings

Changes in physical geography caused by living organisms

708
CHAPTER XLV.

Imbedding of organic remains in peat, blown sand, and volcanic ejections

Imbedding of organic remains in peat, blown sand, and volcanic ash

718
CHAPTER XLVI.

Imbedding of the same in alluvial deposits and in caves

Imbedding of the same in river sediment and in caves

730
CHAPTER XLVII.

Imbedding of organic remains in aqueous deposits—Terrestrial plants—Insects, reptiles, birds, quadrupeds

Imbedding of organic remains in water deposits—Land plants—Insects, reptiles, birds, mammals

742
CHAPTER XLVIII.

Imbedding of the remains of man and his works

Imbedding of the remains of humans and their creations

753
CHAPTER XLIX.

Imbedding of aquatic animals and plants, both freshwater and marine, in aqueous deposits

Imbedding of aquatic animals and plants, both freshwater and marine, in water-based deposits

765
CHAPTER L.

Formation of coral reefs

How coral reefs form

775

LIST OF PLATES.

DIRECTIONS TO THE FOLDER.

Cover page, View of the Temple of Serapis at Puzzuoli in 1836, to face title page. to face title page.
Plate 1. Map showing the Area in Europe which has been covered by Water since the beginning of the Eocene Period to face p. 121
  2. Boulders drifted by Ice on the Shores of the St. Lawrence. 220
  3. View looking up the Val del Bove, Etna. 408
  4. View of the Val del Bove, Etna, as seen from above 404

PRINCIPLES OF GEOLOGY.


BOOK I.

CHAPTER I.

Geology defined—Compared to History—Its relation to other Physical Sciences—Not to be confounded with Cosmogony.

Geology is the science which investigates the successive changes that have taken place in the organic and inorganic kingdoms of nature; it inquires into the causes of these changes, and the influence which they have exerted in modifying the surface and external structure of our planet.

Geology is the science that studies the series of changes that have occurred in the organic and inorganic aspects of nature. It looks into the reasons behind these changes and how they have impacted the surface and external structure of our planet.

By these researches into the state of the earth and its inhabitants at former periods, we acquire a more perfect knowledge of its present condition, and more comprehensive views concerning the laws now governing its animate and inanimate productions. When we study history, we obtain a more profound insight into human nature, by instituting a comparison between the present and former states of society. We trace the long series of events which have gradually led to the actual posture of affairs; and by connecting effects with their causes, we are enabled to classify and retain in the memory a multitude of complicated relations—the various peculiarities of national character—the different degrees of moral and intellectual refinement, and numerous other circumstances, which, without historical associations, would be uninteresting or imperfectly understood. As the present condition of nations is the result of many antecedent changes, some extremely remote, and others recent, some gradual, others sudden and violent; so the state, of the natural world is the result of a long succession of events; and if we would enlarge our experience of the present economy of nature, we must investigate the effects of her operations in former epochs.

By researching the state of the earth and its inhabitants in earlier times, we gain a clearer understanding of its current condition and a broader perspective on the laws that now govern living and non-living things. When we study history, we gain a deeper insight into human nature by comparing today’s society with past societies. We can trace the long series of events that have gradually shaped the current situation, and by linking causes to their effects, we can organize and remember a complex array of relationships—the unique traits of different national characters—the varying levels of moral and intellectual development, and many other aspects that would otherwise be dull or only partially understood without historical context. Just as the current status of nations results from many previous changes—some very old, others recent, some gradual, and others sudden and drastic—the state of the natural world comes from a lengthy series of events. To broaden our understanding of today's natural environment, we need to examine the effects of nature's processes in earlier periods.

We often discover with surprise, on looking back into the chronicles of nations, how the fortune of some battle has influenced the fate of millions of our contemporaries, when it has long been forgotten by the mass of the population. With this remote event we may find inseparably connected the geographical boundaries of a great state, the language now spoken by the inhabitants, their peculiar manners, laws, and religious opinions. But far more astonishing and unexpected are the connections brought to light, when we carry back our researches into the history of nature. The form of a coast, the configuration of the in2terior of a country, the existence and extent of lakes, valleys, and mountains, can often be traced to the former prevalence of earthquakes and volcanoes in regions which have long been undisturbed. To these remote convulsions the present fertility of some districts, the sterile character of others, the elevation of land above the sea, the climate, and various peculiarities, may be distinctly referred. On the other hand, many distinguishing features of the surface may often be ascribed to the operation, at a remote era, of slow and tranquil causes—to the gradual deposition of sediment in a lake or in the ocean, or to the prolific increase of testacea and corals.

We often find it surprising, when we look back at history, how the outcome of a particular battle has shaped the lives of millions, even if that event has been long forgotten by most people. Tied to this distant event are the boundaries of a great nation, the language spoken by its people, their unique customs, laws, and religious beliefs. But even more astonishing are the connections we uncover when we explore the history of nature. The shape of a coastline, the layout of a country’s interior, the size and presence of lakes, valleys, and mountains can often be traced back to past earthquakes and volcanic activity in areas that have since been calm. These ancient disturbances can explain the current fertility of certain regions, the barren nature of others, the elevation of land above sea level, the climate, and various distinct characteristics. Conversely, many features of the landscape can often be linked to the effects of gradual and peaceful processes from a long time ago—like the slow accumulation of sediment in a lake or ocean, or the abundant growth of shellfish and corals.

To select another example, we find in certain localities subterranean deposits of coal, consisting of vegetable matter, formerly drifted into seas and lakes. These seas and lakes have since been filled up, the lands whereon the forests grew have disappeared or changed their form, the rivers and currents which floated the vegetable masses can no longer be traced, and the plants belonged to species which for ages have passed away from the surface of our planet. Yet the commercial prosperity, and numerical strength of a nation, may now be mainly dependent on the local distribution of fuel determined by that ancient state of things.

To choose another example, we find in some areas underground deposits of coal made up of plant material that used to drift into seas and lakes. These seas and lakes are now filled in, the land where the forests once grew has vanished or changed shape, the rivers and currents that carried the plant matter can no longer be identified, and the plants were from species that have long disappeared from the surface of our planet. Still, a nation's commercial success and population size may now greatly depend on the local availability of fuel shaped by that ancient situation.

Geology is intimately related to almost all the physical sciences, as history is to the moral. An historian should, if possible, be at once profoundly acquainted with ethics, politics, jurisprudence, the military art, theology; in a word, with all branches of knowledge by which any insight into human affairs, or into the moral and intellectual nature of man, can be obtained. It would be no less desirable that a geologist should be well versed in chemistry, natural philosophy, mineralogy, zoology, comparative anatomy, botany; in short, in every science relating to organic and inorganic nature. With these accomplishments, the historian and geologist would rarely fail to draw correct and philosophical conclusions from the various monuments transmitted to them of former occurrences. They would know to what combination of causes analogous effects were referable, and they would often be enabled to supply, by inference, information concerning many events unrecorded in the defective archives of former ages. But as such extensive acquisitions are scarcely within the reach of any individual, it is necessary that men who have devoted their lives to different departments should unite their efforts; and as the historian receives assistance from the antiquary, and from those who have cultivated different branches of moral and political science, so the geologist should avail himself of the aid of many naturalists, and particularly of those who have studied the fossil remains of lost species of animals and plants.

Geology is closely connected to almost all the physical sciences, just like history is connected to the moral sciences. A historian should ideally have a deep understanding of ethics, politics, law, military strategy, and theology; in other words, all fields of knowledge that provide insight into human affairs or into the moral and intellectual nature of humanity. Similarly, a geologist should be knowledgeable in chemistry, natural philosophy, mineralogy, zoology, comparative anatomy, and botany; in short, in every science related to both organic and inorganic nature. With these skills, both historians and geologists would rarely fail to draw accurate and thoughtful conclusions from the various artifacts left by past events. They would understand which combinations of causes lead to similar effects and could often infer information about many events that are missing from the incomplete records of earlier times. However, since it's nearly impossible for any one person to possess such extensive knowledge, it's essential for individuals who have dedicated their lives to different fields to collaborate. Just as historians receive help from antiquarians and experts in various branches of moral and political science, geologists should seek the support of many naturalists, particularly those who have studied the fossil remains of long-extinct species of animals and plants.

The analogy, however, of the monuments consulted in geology, and those available in history, extends no farther than to one class of historical monuments—those which may be said to be undesignedly commemorative of former events. The canoes, for example, and stone hatchets found in our peat bogs, afford an insight into the rude arts and manners of the earliest inhabitants of our island; the buried coin fixes the date3 of the reign of some Roman emperor; the ancient encampment indicates the districts once occupied by invading armies, and the former method of constructing military defences; the Egyptian mummies throw light on the art of embalming, the rites of sepulture, or the average stature of the human race in ancient Egypt. This class of memorials yields to no other in authenticity, but it constitutes a small part only of the resources on which the historian relies, whereas in geology it forms the only kind of evidence which is at our command. For this reason we must not expect to obtain a full and connected account of any series of events beyond the reach of history. But the testimony of geological monuments, if frequently imperfect, possesses at least the advantage of being free from all intentional misrepresentation. We may be deceived in the inferences which we draw, in the same manner as we often mistake the nature and import of phenomena observed in the daily course of nature; but our liability to err is confined to the interpretation, and, if this be correct, our information is certain.

The comparison between the monuments we study in geology and those we find in history only applies to one type of historical monument—those that can be considered unintentionally commemorative of past events. For instance, the canoes and stone tools discovered in our peat bogs provide insight into the primitive skills and lifestyles of the earliest inhabitants of our island; buried coins help us date the reign of specific Roman emperors; ancient campsites indicate the areas once occupied by invading armies and show us how military defenses were constructed; and Egyptian mummies reveal details about the art of embalming, burial rites, or the average height of people in ancient Egypt. This type of monument is as authentic as any, but it only makes up a small part of what historians rely on, while in geology, it's the only evidence we have. Because of this, we shouldn’t expect to get a complete and coherent account of any series of events that go beyond the scope of history. However, while the evidence from geological monuments may often be incomplete, it at least has the benefit of being free from any intentional distortion. We might misinterpret the conclusions we draw, just as we frequently misjudge the nature and significance of phenomena we observe in our daily lives; but our potential for error is limited to how we interpret things, and if our interpretation is accurate, then our information is reliable.

It was long before the distinct nature and legitimate objects of geology were fully recognized, and it was at first confounded with many other branches of inquiry, just as the limits of history, poetry, and mythology were ill-defined in the infancy of civilization. Even in Werner's time, or at the close of the eighteenth century, geology appears to have been regarded as little other than a subordinate department of mineralogy; and Desmarest included it under the head of Physical Geography. But the most common and serious source of confusion arose from the notion, that it was the business of geology to discover the mode in which the earth originated, or, as some imagined, to study the effects of those cosmological causes which were employed by the Author of Nature to bring this planet out of a nascent and chaotic state into a more perfect and habitable condition. Hutton was the first who endeavored to draw a strong line of demarcation between his favorite science and cosmogony, for he declared that geology was in nowise concerned "with questions as to the origin of things."

It took a long time for the unique aspects and valid purposes of geology to be fully understood, and it was initially mixed up with many other fields of study, just like the boundaries of history, poetry, and mythology were unclear in the early stages of civilization. Even in Werner's time, around the end of the eighteenth century, geology seemed to be seen as nothing more than a minor part of mineralogy; Desmarest even categorized it under Physical Geography. However, the most common and significant source of confusion came from the belief that geology's job was to uncover how the earth was formed or, as some believed, to examine the effects of the cosmic forces that the Creator used to transform this planet from a chaotic, early state into a more developed and livable one. Hutton was the first to try to clearly separate his favorite science from cosmogony, as he stated that geology was not at all concerned "with questions about the origin of things."

An attempt will be made in the sequel of this work to demonstrate that geology differs as widely from cosmogony, as speculations concerning the mode of the first creation of man differ from history. But, before entering more at large on this controverted question, it will be desirable to trace the progress of opinion on this topic, from the earliest ages to the commencement of the present century.

An attempt will be made in the following sections of this work to show that geology is as different from cosmogony as theories about how humans were first created are from history. However, before diving deeper into this debated issue, it will be useful to outline the evolution of thought on this topic from ancient times up to the start of the current century.


CHAPTER II.

HISTORICAL SKETCH OF THE PROGRESS OF GEOLOGY.

Oriental Cosmogony—Hymns of the Vedas—Institutes of Menù—Doctrine of the successive destruction and renovation of the world—Origin of this doctrine—Common to the Egyptians—Adopted by the Greeks—System of Pythagoras—Of Aristotle—Dogmas concerning the extinction and reproduction of genera and species—Strabo's theory of elevation by earthquakes—Pliny—Concluding Remarks on the knowledge of the Ancients.

Oriental Cosmogony—Hymns of the Vedas—Institutes of Menu—Doctrine of the ongoing destruction and rebirth of the world—Origin of this doctrine—Shared by the Egyptians—Embraced by the Greeks—Pythagorean system—Aristotle's views—Beliefs about the extinction and reproduction of genera and species—Strabo's theory on elevation due to earthquakes—Pliny—Final thoughts on the knowledge of the Ancients.

Oriental Cosmogony.—The earliest doctrines of the Indian and Egyptian schools of philosophy agreed in ascribing the first creation of the world to an omnipotent and infinite Being. They concurred also in representing this Being, who had existed from all eternity, as having repeatedly destroyed and reproduced the world and all its inhabitants. In the sacred volume of the Hindoos, called the Ordinances of Menù, comprising the Indian system of duties religious and civil, we find a preliminary chapter treating of the Creation, in which the cosmogony is known to have been derived from earlier writings and traditions; and principally from certain hymns of high antiquity, called the Vedas. These hymns were first put together, according to Mr. Colebrooke,1 in a connected series, about thirteen centuries before the Christian era, but they appear from internal evidence to have been written at various antecedent periods. In them, as we learn from the researches of Professor Wilson, the eminent Sanscrit scholar, two distinct philosophical systems are discoverable. According to one of them, all things were originally brought into existence by the sole will of a single First Cause, which existed from eternity; according to the other, there have always existed two principles, the one material, but without form, the other spiritual and capable of compelling "inert matter to develop its sensible properties." This development of matter into "individual and visible existences" is called creation, and is assigned to a subordinate agent, or the creative faculty of the Supreme Being embodied in the person of Brahma.

Oriental Cosmogony.—The earliest beliefs of the Indian and Egyptian schools of philosophy both stated that an all-powerful and infinite Being was responsible for the creation of the world. They also agreed that this Being, who had existed for all eternity, had repeatedly destroyed and recreated the world and all its inhabitants. In the sacred text of the Hindoos, known as the Ordinances of Menù, which outlines the Indian system of religious and civil duties, there is an introductory chapter discussing Creation, where the cosmogony is known to have been influenced by earlier writings and traditions, primarily from ancient hymns called the Vedas. According to Mr. Colebrooke,1 these hymns were compiled into a connected series about thirteen centuries before the Christian era, but internal evidence suggests they were written at various earlier times. From the research of Professor Wilson, a prominent Sanskrit scholar, we see that two distinct philosophical systems can be identified in these texts. One asserts that everything was created solely by the will of a single First Cause that has existed eternally; the other posits that two principles have always existed: one material and formless, and the other spiritual, which is capable of making "inert matter develop its sensible properties." This process of matter developing into "individual and visible existences" is called creation and is attributed to a subordinate agent or the creative aspect of the Supreme Being, embodied in the figure of Brahma.

In the first chapter of the Ordinances of Menù above alluded to, we meet with the following passages relating to former destructions and renovations of the world:—

In the first chapter of the Ordinances of Menù mentioned earlier, we come across the following sections about past destructions and renewals of the world:—

"The Being, whose powers are incomprehensible, having created me (Menù) and this universe, again became absorbed in the supreme spirit, changing the time of energy for the hour of repose.

"The Being, whose powers are beyond our understanding, having created me (Menù) and this universe, became absorbed once more in the supreme spirit, shifting from a time of energy to a time of rest."

"When that Power awakes, then has this world its full expansion; but when he slumbers with a tranquil spirit, then the whole system fades away..... For while he reposes, as it were, embodied spirits 5endowed with principles of action depart from their several acts, and the mind itself becomes inert."

"When that Power awakens, the world reaches its full potential; but when he rests peacefully, the entire system starts to fade away..... While he is at rest, like embodied spirits 5 with principles of action, they detach from their actions, and the mind itself becomes inactive."

The absorption of all beings into the Supreme essence is then described, and the Divine soul itself is said to slumber, and to remain for a time immersed in "the first idea, or in darkness." After which the text thus proceeds (verse fifty-seven), "Thus that immutable power by waking and reposing alternately, revivifies and destroys, in eternal succession, this whole assemblage of locomotive and immovable creatures."

The merging of all beings into the Supreme essence is then explained, and the Divine soul is said to be in a state of rest, temporarily lost in "the first idea, or in darkness." Following that, the text continues (verse fifty-seven), "So that unchanging power, by alternating between waking and resting, gives life to and destroys this entire collection of moving and stationary creatures in an endless cycle."

It is then declared that there has been a long succession of manwantaras, or periods, each of the duration of many thousand ages, and—

It is then stated that there has been a long series of manwantaras, or periods, each lasting for many thousands of years, and—

"There are creations also, and destructions of worlds innumerable: the Being, supremely exalted, performs all this with as much ease as if in sport, again and again, for the sake of conferring happiness."2

"There are countless creations and destructions of worlds. The supreme Being does all this as easily as if it were just a game, over and over, to bring happiness." 2

No part of the Eastern cosmogony, from which these extracts are made, is more interesting to the geologist than the doctrine, so frequently alluded to, of the reiterated submersion of the land beneath the waters of a universal ocean. In the beginning of things, we are told, the First Sole Cause "with a thought created the waters," and then moved upon their surface in the form of Brahma the creator, by whose agency the emergence of the dry land was effected, and the peopling of the earth with plants, animals, celestial creatures, and man. Afterwards, as often as a general conflagration at the close of each manwantara had annihilated every visible and existing thing, Brahma, on awaking from his sleep, finds the whole world a shapeless ocean. Accordingly, in the legendary poems called the Puranas, composed at a later date than the Vedas, the three first Avatars or descents of the Deity upon earth have for their object to recover the land from the waters. For this purpose Vishnu is made successively to assume the form of a fish, a tortoise, and a boar.

No part of the Eastern cosmogony, from which these extracts are taken, is more intriguing to a geologist than the idea, often mentioned, of the repeated drowning of land beneath a universal ocean. In the beginning, we are told, the First Sole Cause "with a thought created the waters," and then moved over their surface in the form of Brahma the creator, through whom dry land emerged and the earth was filled with plants, animals, celestial beings, and humans. Later, every time a great fire at the end of each manwantara destroyed everything in sight, Brahma, waking from his sleep, finds the entire world to be a formless ocean. So, in the legendary poems known as the Puranas, written after the Vedas, the first three Avatars or descents of the Deity onto earth aim to bring the land back from the waters. For this, Vishnu takes on the forms of a fish, a tortoise, and a boar.

Extravagant as may be some of the conceits and fictions which disfigure these pretended revelations, we can by no means look upon them as a pure effort of the unassisted imagination, or believe them to have been composed without regard to opinions and theories founded on the observation of Nature. In astronomy, for instance, it is declared that, at the North Pole, the year was divided into a long day and night, and that their long day was the northern, and their night the southern course of the sun; and to the inhabitants of the moon, it is said one day is equal in length to one month of mortals.3 If such statements cannot be resolved into mere conjectures, we have no right to refer to mere chance the prevailing notion that the earth and its inhabitants had formerly undergone a succession of revolutions and aqueous catastrophes interrupted by long intervals of tranquillity.

As extravagant as some of the ideas and stories in these supposed revelations may be, we can't simply see them as a product of pure imagination or think they were created without considering the opinions and theories based on the observation of nature. For example, in astronomy, it's stated that at the North Pole, the year is divided into a long day and a long night, with their long day corresponding to the northern path of the sun and their night to the southern path. It's also mentioned that for the inhabitants of the moon, one day is equal in length to one month for humans.3 If these statements can't just be dismissed as mere speculation, we shouldn't attribute the common belief that the Earth and its inhabitants have experienced a series of revolutions and water-related disasters interrupted by long periods of calm to mere chance.

Now there are two sources in which such a theory may have originated. The marks of former convulsions on every part of the surface of 6our planet are obvious and striking. The remains of marine animals imbedded in the solid strata are so abundant, that they may be expected to force themselves on the attention of every people who have made some progress in refinement; and especially where one class of men are expressly set apart from the rest, like the ancient priesthoods of India and Egypt, for study and contemplation. If these appearances are once recognized, it seems natural that the mind should conclude in favor, not only of mighty changes in past ages, but of alternate periods of repose and disorder;—of repose, when the animals now fossil lived, grew, and multiplied—of disorder, when the strata in which they were buried became transferred from the sea to the interior of continents, and were uplifted so as to form part of high mountain-chains. Those modern writers, who are disposed to disparage the former intellectual advancement and civilization of Eastern nations, may concede some foundation of observed facts for the curious theories now under consideration, without indulging in exaggerated opinions of the progress of science; especially as universal catastrophes of the world, and exterminations of organic beings, in the sense in which they were understood by the Brahmins, are untenable doctrines.

Now there are two possible sources from which this theory could have come. The evidence of past upheavals on every part of the surface of 6 our planet is clear and striking. The remains of marine animals embedded in solid layers are so plentiful that they are likely to capture the attention of any society that has made some advances in culture, especially where a specific group of people, like the ancient priesthoods of India and Egypt, is set apart for study and reflection. Once these signs are recognized, it seems natural for the mind to conclude that there were not only significant changes in ancient times but also alternating periods of calm and chaos—of calm when the now-fossilized animals lived, grew, and multiplied, and of chaos when the layers in which they were buried were moved from the sea to the interior of continents, eventually being raised to form parts of high mountain ranges. Those modern authors who tend to underestimate the prior intellectual development and civilization of Eastern nations might acknowledge some basis of observed facts for the intriguing theories currently under discussion, without falling into overly optimistic views of scientific progress; especially considering that the idea of universal disasters and mass extinction of living beings, as understood by the Brahmins, is an indefensible belief.

We know that the Egyptian priests were aware, not only that the soil beneath the plains of the Nile, but that also the hills bounding the great valley, contained marine shells; and Herodotus inferred from these facts, that all lower Egypt, and even the high lands above Memphis, had once been covered by the sea.4 As similar fossil remains occur in all parts of Asia hitherto explored, far in the interior of the continent as well as near the sea, they could hardly have escaped detection by some Eastern sages not less capable than the Greek historian of reasoning philosophically on natural phenomena.

We know that the Egyptian priests recognized that not only the soil under the Nile plains but also the hills surrounding the great valley contained marine shells. Herodotus concluded from this that all of lower Egypt, and even the highlands above Memphis, had once been underwater.4 Since similar fossil remains have been found throughout all explored parts of Asia, both deep inland and near the sea, it’s unlikely that some Eastern thinkers, just as capable as the Greek historian in reasoning about natural phenomena, wouldn't have noticed them.

We also know that the rulers of Asia were engaged in very remote eras in executing great national works, such as tanks and canals, requiring extensive excavations. In the fourteenth century of our era (in the year 1360), the removal of soil necessary for such undertakings brought to light geological facts, which attracted the attention of a people less civilized than were many of the older nations of the East. The historian Ferishta relates that fifty thousand laborers were employed in cutting through a mound, so as to form a junction between the rivers Selima and Sutlej; and in this mound were found the bones of elephants and men, some of them petrified, and some of them resembling bone. The gigantic dimensions attributed to the human bones show them to have belonged to some of the larger pachydermata.5

We also know that the rulers of Asia in ancient times were involved in big national projects, like building tanks and canals, which required large-scale digging. In the 14th century (specifically in 1360), the soil removal needed for these projects uncovered geological facts that caught the interest of a society less advanced than some of the older nations in the East. The historian Ferishta states that fifty thousand workers were used to dig through a mound to create a connection between the rivers Selima and Sutlej; within this mound, they discovered bones of elephants and humans, some of which were fossilized and others resembling bone. The enormous size of the human bones indicates that they belonged to some of the larger pachyderms.5

But, although the Brahmins, like the priests of Egypt, may have 7 been acquainted with the existence of fossil remains in the strata, it is possible that the doctrine of successive destructions and renovations of the world, merely received corroboration from such proofs; and that it may have been originally handed down, like the religious traditions of most nations, from a ruder state of society. The system may have had its source, in part at least, in exaggerated accounts of those dreadful catastrophes which are occasioned by particular combinations of natural causes. Floods and volcanic eruptions, the agency of water and fire, are the chief instruments of devastation on our globe. We shall point out in the sequel the extent of many of these calamities, recurring at distant intervals of time, in the present course of nature; and shall only observe here, that they are so peculiarly calculated to inspire a lasting terror, and are so often fatal in their consequences to great multitudes of people, that it scarcely requires the passion for the marvellous, so characteristic of rude and half-civilized nations, still less the exuberant imagination of Eastern writers, to augment them into general cataclysms and conflagrations.

But even though the Brahmins, like the priests of Egypt, might have known about the existence of fossil remains in the layers of the earth, it’s possible that their belief in the world going through cycles of destruction and renewal just got some support from these proofs. This idea may have originally been passed down, like religious traditions in many cultures, from a more primitive society. The system might have partly come from exaggerated stories of those terrible disasters caused by specific natural events. Floods and volcanic eruptions, driven by water and fire, are the main forces of destruction on our planet. We will highlight later the scale of many of these disasters, which happen at long intervals in the natural order; and I’ll just add here that they are so effective at causing lasting fear, and so often deadly for many people, that it hardly needs the fascination with the extraordinary, typical of primitive and semi-civilized cultures, or the vivid imagination of Eastern writers, to blow them up into widespread cataclysms and fires.

The great flood of the Chinese, which their traditions carry back to the period of Yaou, something more than 2000 years before our era, has been identified by some persons with the universal deluge described in the Old Testament; but according to Mr. Davis, who accompanied two of our embassies to China, and who has carefully examined their written accounts, the Chinese cataclysm is therein described as interrupting the business of agriculture, rather than as involving a general destruction of the human race. The great Yu was celebrated for having "opened nine channels to draw off the waters," which "covered the low hills and bathed the foot of the highest mountains." Mr. Davis suggests that a great derangement of waters of the Yellow River, one of the largest in the world, might even now cause the flood of Yaou to be repeated, and lay the most fertile and populous plains of China under water. In modern times the bursting of the banks of an artificial canal, into which a portion of the Yellow River has been turned, has repeatedly given rise to the most dreadful accidents, and is a source of perpetual anxiety to the government. It is easy, therefore, to imagine how much greater may have been the inundation, if this valley was ever convulsed by a violent earthquake.6

The great flood in China, which their traditions trace back to the time of Yaou, over 2000 years before our era, has been linked by some to the universal flood described in the Old Testament. However, according to Mr. Davis, who went with two of our embassies to China and carefully analyzed their written records, the Chinese disaster is described as disrupting agriculture rather than resulting in the total destruction of humanity. The legendary Yu was famous for having "opened nine channels to drain off the waters," which "covered the low hills and soaked the base of the tallest mountains." Mr. Davis suggests that a significant disturbance of the Yellow River, one of the largest rivers in the world, could still lead to a repeat of the Yaou flood, submerging the most fertile and populated plains of China. In modern times, the collapse of banks of an artificial canal that diverts part of the Yellow River has frequently caused horrific accidents and remains a constant worry for the government. It's easy to imagine how much more severe the flooding could have been if this region had ever been shaken by a powerful earthquake.6

Humboldt relates the interesting fact that, after the annihilation of a large part of the inhabitants of Cumana, by an earthquake in 1766, a season of extraordinary fertility ensued, in consequence of the great rains which accompanied the subterranean convulsions. "The Indians," he says, "celebrated, after the ideas of an antique superstition, by festivals and dancing, the destruction of the world and the approaching epoch of its regeneration."7

Humboldt shares the interesting fact that after a significant number of people in Cumana were killed by an earthquake in 1766, a period of exceptional fertility followed due to the heavy rains that came with the underground disturbances. "The Indians," he states, "celebrated, based on ancient superstitions, with festivals and dancing, the end of the world and the upcoming era of its renewal."7

The existence of such rites among the rude nations of South America 8 is most important, as showing what effects may be produced by local catastrophes, recurring at distant intervals of time, on the minds of a barbarous and uncultivated race. I shall point out in the sequel how the tradition of a deluge among the Araucanian Indians may be explained, by reference to great earthquake-waves which have repeatedly rolled over part of Chili since the first recorded flood of 1590. (See chap. 29, Book II.) The legend also of the ancient Peruvians of an inundation many years before the reign of the Incas, in which only six persons were saved on a float, relates to a region which has more than once been overwhelmed by inroads of the ocean since the days of Pizarro. (Chap. 29, Book II.) I might refer the reader to my account of the submergence of a wide area in Cutch so lately as the year 1819, when a single tower only of the fort of Sindree appeared above the waste of waters (see Chap. 28, Book II.), if it were necessary, to prove how easily the catastrophes of modern times might give rise to traditionary narratives, among a rude people, of floods of boundless extent. Nations without written records, and who are indebted for all their knowledge of past events exclusively to oral tradition, are in the habit of confounding in one legend a series of incidents which have happened at various epochs; nor must we forget that the superstitions of a savage tribe are transmitted through all the progressive stages of society, till they exert a powerful influence on the mind of the philosopher. He may find, in the monuments of former changes on the earth's surface, an apparent confirmation of tenets handed down through successive generations, from the rude hunter, whose terrified imagination drew a false picture of those awful visitations of floods and earthquakes, whereby the whole earth as known to him was simultaneously devastated.

The existence of such rituals among the primitive tribes of South America 8 is very significant, as it demonstrates the effects that local disasters, occurring at long intervals, can have on the minds of an uncultivated society. I will explain later how the tradition of a flood among the Araucanian Indians can be traced back to major earthquake waves that have repeatedly impacted parts of Chile since the first recorded flood in 1590. (See chap. 29, Book II.) The legend among the ancient Peruvians about a flood many years before the reign of the Incas, in which only six people were saved on a raft, refers to an area that has been inundated multiple times by ocean advances since Pizarro’s time. (Chap. 29, Book II.) I could point you to my account of the flooding of a large area in Cutch as recently as 1819, when only a single tower of the Sindree fort was visible above the flooded land (see Chap. 28, Book II.), to prove how easily the catastrophes of modern times could inspire traditional stories among an uncivilized people about massive floods. Societies without written records, who rely solely on oral tradition for their knowledge of past events, tend to merge different incidents from various periods into a single legend; we must also remember that the superstitions of a primitive tribe can persist through all evolutionary stages of society, influencing the thoughts of philosophers. They may find in the remnants of former changes on the earth's surface a seeming confirmation of beliefs passed down through generations, originating from the primitive hunter, whose fearful imagination created a distorted image of those terrifying floods and earthquakes that devastated his entire known world.

Egyptian Cosmogony.—Respecting the cosmogony of the Egyptian priests, we gather much information from writers of the Grecian sects, who borrowed almost all their tenets from Egypt, and amongst others that of the former successive destruction and renovation of the world.8 We learn from Plutarch, that this was the theme of one of the hymns of Orpheus, so celebrated in the fabulous ages of Greece. It was brought by him from the banks of the Nile; and we even find in his verses, as in the Indian systems, a definite period assigned for the duration of each successive world.9 The returns of great catastrophes were determined by the period of the Annus Magnus, or great year,—a cycle composed of the revolutions of the sun, moon, and planets, and terminating when these return together to the same sign whence they were supposed at some remote epoch to have set out. The duration of this great cycle was variously estimated. According to Orpheus, it was 120,000 years; according to others, 300,000; and by Cassander it was taken to be 360,000 years.10

Egyptian Cosmogony.—Regarding the cosmogony of the Egyptian priests, we gather a lot of information from Greek writers, who borrowed almost all their beliefs from Egypt, including the idea of the world facing successive destruction and renewal.8 We learn from Plutarch that this was the subject of one of Orpheus's hymns, which were highly regarded in the mythical times of Greece. He brought it from the banks of the Nile; and we even find in his verses, similar to the Indian systems, a specific timeframe assigned for the lifespan of each world.9 The occurrences of major disasters were linked to the period of the Annus Magnus, or great year—a cycle made up of the revolutions of the sun, moon, and planets, ending when they return to the same sign from which they were believed to have originated at some distant time. The length of this great cycle was estimated differently. According to Orpheus, it was 120,000 years; others estimated it at 300,000; and Cassander considered it to be 360,000 years.10

9We learn particularly from the Timæus of Plato, that the Egyptians believed the world to be subject to occasional conflagrations and deluges, whereby the gods arrested the career of human wickedness, and purified the earth from guilt. After each regeneration, mankind were in a state of virtue and happiness, from which they gradually degenerated again into vice and immorality. From this Egyptian doctrine, the poets derived the fable of the decline from the golden to the iron age. The sect of Stoics adopted most fully the system of catastrophes destined at certain intervals to destroy the world. Those they taught were of two kinds;—the Cataclysm, or destruction by water, which sweeps away the whole human race, and annihilates all the animal and vegetable productions of nature; and the Ecpyrosis, or destruction by fire, which dissolves the globe itself. From the Egyptians also they derived the doctrine of the gradual debasement of man from a state of innocence. Towards the termination of each era, the gods could no longer bear with the wickedness of men, and a shock of the elements or a deluge overwhelmed them; after which calamity, Astrea again descended on the earth to renew the golden age.11

9We specifically learn from Plato's Timæus that the Egyptians believed the world went through periodic fires and floods, moments when the gods intervened to stop human wrongdoing and cleanse the earth of guilt. After each reset, humanity would be in a state of virtue and happiness, but over time, they would inevitably fall back into vice and immorality. This Egyptian idea inspired poets to create the story of the decline from the golden age to the iron age. The Stoics fully embraced the idea of catastrophic events meant to periodically destroy the world. They recognized two types of destruction: the Cataclysm, a flood that wipes out all of humanity and destroys all animal and plant life, and the Ecpyrosis, a fire that breaks down the earth itself. They also took from the Egyptians the belief in the gradual decline of humans from a state of innocence. As each era came to a close, the gods could no longer tolerate human wickedness, leading to a cataclysm or flood that would drown them; after such disasters, Astraea would descend to the earth to restore the golden age.11

The connection between the doctrine of successive catastrophes and repeated deteriorations in the moral character of the human race is more intimate and natural than might at first be imagined. For, in a rude state of society, all great calamities are regarded by the people as judgments of God on the wickedness of man. Thus, in our own time, the priests persuaded a large part of the population of Chili, and perhaps believed themselves, that the fatal earthquake of 1822 was a sign of the wrath of Heaven for the great political revolution just then consummated in South America. In like manner, in the account given to Solon by the Egyptian priests, of the submersion of the island of Atlantis under the waters of the ocean, after repeated shocks of an earthquake, we find that the event happened when Jupiter had seen the moral depravity of the inhabitants.12 Now, when the notion had once gained ground, whether from causes before suggested or not, that the earth had been destroyed by several general catastrophes, it would next be inferred that the human race had been as often destroyed and renovated. And since every extermination was assumed to be penal, it could only be reconciled with divine justice, by the supposition that man, at each successive creation, was regenerated in a state of purity and innocence.

The link between the idea of recurring disasters and the ongoing decline in human morality is closer and more natural than one might think. In a primitive society, people view major disasters as divine punishment for humanity's sins. For example, in modern times, priests convinced many people in Chile, and perhaps believed it themselves, that the deadly earthquake of 1822 was a sign of God's anger over the significant political upheaval that had just occurred in South America. Similarly, in the story told to Solon by Egyptian priests about the sinking of the island of Atlantis after multiple earthquakes, it is noted that this event took place when Jupiter had observed the moral decay of its people.12 Once the idea took hold—regardless of the reasons behind it—that the earth had experienced several major catastrophes, it followed that humanity must have also been repeatedly destroyed and renewed. Since each destruction was viewed as punishment, it could only be justified within the framework of divine justice by believing that each time humanity was created anew, it was in a state of purity and innocence.

A very large portion of Asia, inhabited by the earliest nations, whose traditions have come down to us, has been always subject to tremendous earthquakes. Of the geographical boundaries of these, and their effects, I shall speak in the proper place. Egypt has, for the most part, been exempt from this scourge, and the Egyptian doctrine of great catastrophes was probably derived in part, as before hinted, from early geological observations, and in part from Eastern nations.

A huge part of Asia, home to some of the oldest civilizations whose traditions we still know, has always experienced massive earthquakes. I will discuss the geographical boundaries and their effects in the appropriate section. Egypt has mostly been free from this disaster, and the Egyptian belief in major catastrophes likely came from a mix of early geological observations and influences from Eastern cultures.

Pythagorean Doctrines.—Pythagoras, who resided for more than 10 twenty years in Egypt, and, according to Cicero, had visited the East, and conversed with the Persian philosophers, introduced into his own country, on his return, the doctrine of the gradual deterioration of the human race from an original state of virtue and happiness; but if we are to judge of his theory concerning the destruction and renovation of the earth from the sketch given by Ovid, we must concede it to have been far more philosophical than any known version of the cosmogonies of Oriental or Egyptian sects.

Pythagorean Doctrines.—Pythagoras, who spent over 10 twenty years in Egypt and, according to Cicero, traveled to the East to talk with Persian philosophers, brought back to his homeland the idea that the human race gradually declines from an original state of virtue and happiness. However, if we judge his theory about the earth's destruction and renewal based on the outline provided by Ovid, we must acknowledge that it was much more philosophical than any known versions of the creation myths from Oriental or Egyptian traditions.

Although Pythagoras is introduced by the poet as delivering his doctrine in person, some of the illustrations are derived from natural events which happened after the death of the philosopher. But notwithstanding these anachronisms, we may regard the account as a true picture of the tenets of the Pythagorean school in the Augustan age; and although perhaps partially modified, it must have contained the substance of the original scheme. Thus considered, it is extremely curious and instructive; for we here find a comprehensive summary of almost all the great causes of change now in activity on the globe, and these adduced in confirmation of a principle of a perpetual and gradual revolution inherent in the nature of our terrestrial system. These doctrines, it is true, are not directly applied to the explanation of geological phenomena; or, in other words, no attempt is made to estimate what may have been in past ages, or what may hereafter be, the aggregate amount of change brought about by such never-ending fluctuations. Had this been the case, we might have been called upon to admire so extraordinary an anticipation with no less interest than astronomers, when they endeavor to define by what means the Samian philosopher came to the knowledge of the Copernican system.

Although the poet presents Pythagoras as sharing his teachings in person, some of the examples come from natural events that occurred after the philosopher's death. However, despite these inconsistencies, we can view the account as a reliable representation of the beliefs of the Pythagorean school during the Augustan era. While it may be somewhat altered, it must still contain the core principles of the original philosophy. When looked at this way, it's quite fascinating and informative; as it offers a broad overview of nearly all the significant factors driving change on Earth today, presented as support for a principle of ongoing and gradual revolution inherent in our planet's nature. These ideas are not straightforwardly linked to explaining geological phenomena; in other words, there's no effort to estimate what the total amount of change has been in the past or what it will continue to be due to these endless fluctuations. If that were the case, we might have been urged to marvel at such an impressive prediction with just as much interest as astronomers do when they try to determine how the Samian philosopher understood the Copernican system.

Let us now examine the celebrated passages to which we have been adverting:13

Let’s now take a look at the well-known sections we’ve been referring to:13

"Nothing perishes in this world; but things merely vary and change their form. To be born, means simply that a thing begins to be something different from what it was before; and dying, is ceasing to be the same thing. Yet, although nothing retains long the same image, the sum of the whole remains constant." These general propositions are then confirmed by a series of examples, all derived from natural appearances, except the first, which refers to the golden age giving place to the age of iron. The illustrations are thus consecutively adduced.

"Nothing really disappears in this world; things just change and take on different forms. To be born means that something starts to be different from what it was before, and dying is just stopping to be the same thing. However, even though nothing stays the same for long, the total amount remains constant." These general statements are then supported by a series of examples, all taken from natural occurrences, except for the first one, which talks about the golden age being replaced by the age of iron. The examples are then presented in order.

1. Solid land has been converted into sea.

1. Solid ground has turned into ocean.

2. Sea has been changed into land. Marine shells lie far distant from the deep, and the anchor has been found on the summit of hills.

2. The sea has turned into land. Marine shells are now far away from the deep water, and anchors have been discovered on the tops of hills.

3. Valleys have been excavated by running water, and floods have washed down hills into the sea.14

3. Rivers have carved out valleys, and floods have swept debris from the hills into the ocean.14

11 4. Marshes have become dry ground.

11 4. Marshes have turned into dry land.

5. Dry lands have been changed into stagnant pools.

5. Dry lands have turned into stagnant pools.

6. During earthquakes some springs have been closed up, and new ones have broken out. Rivers have deserted their channels, and have been re-born elsewhere, as the Erasinus in Greece, and Mysus in Asia.

6. During earthquakes, some springs have dried up, and new ones have emerged. Rivers have left their original paths and have started anew in different places, like the Erasinus in Greece and the Mysus in Asia.

7. The waters of some rivers, formerly sweet, have become bitter; as those of the Anigris, in Greece, &c.15

7. The waters of some rivers that used to be fresh have turned bitter; like those of the Anigris in Greece, etc.15

8. Islands have become connected with the mainland by the growth of deltas and new deposits; as in the case of Antissa joined to Lesbos, Pharos to Egypt, &c.

8. Islands have become linked to the mainland through the formation of deltas and new deposits, as seen with Antissa connecting to Lesbos, Pharos to Egypt, etc.

9. Peninsulas have been divided from the main land, and have become islands, as Leucadia; and according to tradition, Sicily, the sea having carried away the isthmus.

9. Peninsulas have been separated from the mainland and have turned into islands, like Leucadia; and according to tradition, Sicily, with the sea having washed away the isthmus.

10. Land has been submerged by earthquakes; the Grecian cities of Helice and Buris, for example, are to be seen under the sea, with their walls inclined.

10. Land has been submerged by earthquakes; the Greek cities of Helice and Buris, for example, can be seen underwater, with their walls leaning.

11. Plains have been upheaved into hills by the confined air seeking vent; as at Trœzene in the Peloponnesus.

11. Plains have been raised into hills by the trapped air looking for an escape, like at Trœzene in the Peloponnesus.

12. The temperature of some springs varies at different periods. The waters of others are inflammable.16

12. The temperature of some springs changes at different times. The waters of others are flammable.16

13. There are streams which have a petrifying power, and convert the substances which they touch into marble.

13. There are streams that have the ability to turn anything they touch into marble.

14. Extraordinary medicinal and deleterious effects are produced by the water of different lakes and springs.17

14. Different lakes and springs have remarkable healing and harmful effects. 17

15. Some rocks and islands, after floating and having been subject to violent movements, have at length become stationary and immovable; as Delos and the Cyanean Isles.18

15. Some rocks and islands, after floating around and experiencing violent movements, have finally become still and unmovable; like Delos and the Cyanean Isles.18

16. Volcanic vents shift their position; there was a time when Etna was not a burning mountain, and the time will come when it will cease to burn. Whether it be that some caverns become closed up by the movements of the earth, and others opened, or whether the fuel is finally exhausted, &c., &c.

16. Volcanic vents change their locations; there was a time when Etna wasn't a burning mountain, and there will come a time when it stops burning. It could be that some caves get sealed off by the earth's movements, and others get opened up, or that the fuel eventually runs out, etc., etc.

The various causes of change in the inanimate world having been thus enumerated, the doctrine of equivocal generation is next propounded, as illustrating a corresponding perpetual flux in the animate creation.19

The different reasons for change in the non-living world have been listed, and now the idea of spontaneous generation is introduced, showing a similar constant change in living beings.19

12In the Egyptian and Eastern cosmogonies, and in the Greek version of them, no very definite meaning can, in general, be attached to the term "destruction of the world;" for sometimes it would seem almost to imply the annihilation of our planetary system, and at others a mere revolution of the surface of the earth.

12In Egyptian and Eastern creation stories, as well as in the Greek versions, the term "destruction of the world" doesn't really have a clear meaning. Sometimes it seems to suggest the complete destruction of our planetary system, while at other times it just refers to a change in the surface of the earth.

Opinions of Aristotle.—From the works now extant of Aristotle, and from the system of Pythagoras, as above exposed, we might certainly infer that these philosophers considered the agents of change now operating in nature, as capable of bringing about in the lapse of ages a complete revolution; and the Stagyrite even considers occasional catastrophes, happening at distant intervals of time, as part of the regular and ordinary course of nature. The deluge of Deucalion, he says, affected Greece only, and principally the part called Hellas, and it arose from great inundations of rivers, during a rainy winter. But such extraordinary winters, he says, though after a certain period they return, do not always revisit the same places.20

Opinions of Aristotle.—From the works of Aristotle that still exist, along with the teachings of Pythagoras mentioned earlier, we can certainly infer that these philosophers believed the forces of change currently at work in nature are capable of causing a complete transformation over many ages. The Stagyrite even views occasional disasters, occurring at long intervals, as part of the regular and normal course of nature. He states that the flood of Deucalion affected only Greece, primarily the region known as Hellas, and it was caused by major river floods during a rainy winter. However, he notes that while such extraordinary winters may recur after a certain time, they do not always strike the same locations.20

Censorinus quotes it as Aristotle's opinion that there were general inundations of the globe, and that they alternated with conflagrations; and that the flood constituted the winter of the great year, or astronomical cycle, while the conflagration, or destruction by fire, is the summer, or period of greatest heat.21 If this passage, as Lipsius supposes, be an amplification, by Censorinus, of what is written in "the Meteorics," it is a gross misrepresentation of the doctrine of the Stagyrite, for the general bearing of his reasoning in that treatise tends clearly in an opposite direction. He refers to many examples of changes now constantly going on, and insists emphatically on the great results which they must produce in the lapse of ages. He instances particular cases of lakes that had dried up, and deserts that had at length become watered by rivers and fertilized. He points to the growth of the Nilotic Delta since the time of Homer, to the shallowing of the Palus Mæotis within sixty years from his own time; and although, in the same chapter he says nothing of earthquakes, yet in others of the same treatise he shows himself not unacquainted with their effects.22 He alludes, for example, to the upheaving of one of the Eolian islands previous to a volcanic eruption. "The changes of the earth," he says, "are so slow in comparison to the duration of our lives, that they are overlooked (λανθανει): and the migrations of people after great catastrophes, and their removal to other regions, cause the event to be forgotten."23

Censorinus cites Aristotle's view that there were global floods that alternated with fires, suggesting that the flood represented the winter of the great year or astronomical cycle, while the fire represented summer, or the hottest period. If this passage is, as Lipsius suggests, an expansion by Censorinus of what is written in "the Meteorics," then it's a serious misrepresentation of Aristotle's doctrine, as the overall conclusions in that work clearly lean in the other direction. Aristotle refers to numerous examples of ongoing changes and strongly emphasizes the significant impact these changes will have over many ages. He mentions specific cases of lakes that dried up and deserts that eventually became fertile through rivers. He points to the growth of the Nile Delta since Homer's time and the shallowing of the Palus Mæotis within sixty years of his own time; and while he doesn’t mention earthquakes in that chapter, he does acknowledge their effects in other chapters of the same work. For instance, he mentions the uplift of one of the Eolian Islands before a volcanic eruption. "The changes in the earth," he states, "are so slow compared to the duration of our lives that they go unnoticed (λανθανει): and the migrations of populations after major disasters, along with their relocation to other areas, lead to the event being forgotten."

13When we consider the acquaintance displayed by Aristotle, in his various works, with the destroying and renovating powers of Nature, the introductory and concluding passages of the twelfth chapter of his "Meteorics" are certainly very remarkable. In the first sentence he says, "The distribution of land and sea in particular regions does not endure throughout all time, but it becomes sea in those parts where it was land, and again it becomes land where it was sea: and there is reason for thinking that these changes take place according to a certain system, and within a certain period." The concluding observation is as follows:—"As time never fails, and the universe is eternal, neither the Tànais, nor the Nile, can have flowed forever. The places where they rise were once dry, and there is a limit to their operations; but there is none to time. So also of all other rivers; they spring up, and they perish; and the sea also continually deserts some lands and invades others. The same tracts, therefore, of the earth are not, some always sea, and others always continents, but every thing changes in the course of time."

13When we look at Aristotle’s understanding of the destructive and renewing forces of Nature in his various works, the opening and closing passages of the twelfth chapter of his "Meteorics" are definitely noteworthy. In the first sentence, he states, "The arrangement of land and sea in specific areas doesn’t last forever; it turns into sea in places where it was once land, and then becomes land again where it was once sea. There’s reason to believe that these changes follow a certain system and occur within a certain timeframe." The closing point he makes is: "Since time is constant and the universe is eternal, neither the Tanais nor the Nile could have flowed endlessly. The places where they originate were once dry, and there is a limit to their activity; but there is no limit to time. The same goes for all other rivers; they arise and they vanish, and the sea constantly shifts, leaving some areas of land and invading others. Therefore, the same regions of the earth are not always sea or always land; everything changes over time."

It seems, then, that the Greeks had not only derived from preceding nations, but had also, in some slight degree, deduced from their own observations, the theory of periodical revolutions in the inorganic world: there is, however, no ground for imagining that they contemplated former changes in the races of animals and plants. Even the fact that marine remains were inclosed in solid rocks, although observed by some, and even made the groundwork of geological speculation, never stimulated the industry or guided the inquiries of naturalists. It is not impossible that the theory of equivocal generation might have engendered some indifference on this subject, and that a belief in the spontaneous production of living beings from the earth or corrupt matter, might have caused the organic world to appear so unstable and fluctuating, that phenomena indicative of former changes would not awaken intense curiosity. The Egyptians, it is true, had taught, and the Stoics had repeated, that the earth had once given birth to some monstrous animals, which existed no longer; but the prevailing opinion seems to have been, that after each great catastrophe the same species of animals were created over again. This tenet is implied in a passage of Seneca, where, speaking of a future deluge, he says, "Every animal shall be generated anew, and man free from guilt shall be given to the earth."24

It seems, then, that the Greeks didn’t just take ideas from earlier civilizations, but also developed, to some extent, their own theory about periodic changes in the non-living world. However, there’s no reason to think they considered past changes in animal and plant species. Even though some noticed that marine fossils were found in solid rocks, which sparked geological speculation, it didn't really inspire scientists to dig deeper into the subject. It’s possible that the theory of spontaneous generation led to some indifference toward this topic, and that the belief in living things arising from the earth or decaying matter might have made the organic world seem so unstable and changeable that signs of previous changes didn’t generate much interest. The Egyptians taught, and the Stoics echoed, that the earth once produced some bizarre animals that no longer exist; but the general belief appeared to be that after each major catastrophe, the same species of animals were created again. This idea is hinted at in a quote from Seneca, who, while discussing a future flood, says, "Every animal shall be generated anew, and man free from guilt shall be given to the earth."24

An old Arabian version of the doctrine of the successive revolutions of the globe, translated by Abraham Ecchellensis,25 seems to form a singular exception to the general rule, for here we find the idea of different genera and species having been created. The Gerbanites, a sect 14of astronomers who flourished some centuries before the Christian era, taught as follows:—"That after every period of thirty-six thousand four hundred and twenty-five years, there were produced a pair of every species of animal, both male and female, from whom animals might be propagated and inhabit this lower world. But when a circulation of the heavenly orbs was completed, which is finished in that space of years, other genera and species of animals are propagated, as also of plants and other things, and the first order is destroyed, and so it goes on forever and ever."26

An old Arabian version of the theory of the Earth's successive revolutions, translated by Abraham Ecchellensis,25 seems to be a unique exception to the general rule, as it introduces the concept of different genera and species being created. The Gerbanites, a group of astronomers who thrived centuries before the Christian era, taught the following: "After every period of thirty-six thousand four hundred and twenty-five years, a pair of every species of animal, both male and female, is produced, from which animals can reproduce and inhabit this world. However, once a cycle of the heavenly bodies is completed after that time span, other genera and species of animals, as well as plants and other things, emerge, while the original order is destroyed, and this cycle continues endlessly."26

Theory of Strabo.—As we learn much of the tenets of the Egyptian and Oriental schools in the writings of the Greeks, so, many speculations of the early Greek authors are made known to us in the works of the Augustan and later ages. Strabo, in particular, enters largely, in the second book of his Geography, into the opinions of Eratosthenes and other Greeks on one of the most difficult problems in geology, viz., by what causes marine shells came to be plentifully buried in the earth at such great elevations and distances from the sea.

Theory of Strabo.—Just as we learn a lot about the beliefs of the Egyptian and Oriental schools through Greek writings, many theories from early Greek authors are revealed to us in the works from the Augustan period and later. Strabo, in particular, discusses in detail, in the second book of his Geography, the views of Eratosthenes and other Greeks on one of the toughest problems in geology: how marine shells ended up being abundantly buried in the earth at such high elevations and far from the sea.

He notices, amongst others, the explanation of Xanthus the Lydian, who said that the seas had once been more extensive, and that they had afterwards been partially dried up, as in his own time many lakes, rivers, and wells in Asia had failed during a season of drought. Treating this conjecture with merited disregard, Strabo passes on to the hypothesis of Strato, the natural philosopher, who had observed that the quantity of mud brought down by rivers into the Euxine was so great, that its bed must be gradually raised, while the rivers still continue to pour in an undiminished quantity of water. He, therefore, conceived that, originally, when the Euxine was an inland sea, its level had by this means become so much elevated that it burst its barrier near Byzantium, and formed a communication with the Propontis; and this partial drainage, he supposed, had already converted the left side into marshy ground, and thus, at last, the whole would be choked up with soil. So, it was argued, the Mediterranean had once opened a passage for itself by the Columns of Hercules into the Atlantic; and perhaps the abundance of sea-shells in Africa, near the Temple of Jupiter Ammon, might also be the deposit of some former inland sea, which had at length forced a passage and escaped.

He notices, among others, the explanation from Xanthus the Lydian, who claimed that the seas used to cover a larger area and that they had since partially dried up, as in his time many lakes, rivers, and wells in Asia dried up during a drought. Treating this idea with deserved skepticism, Strabo moves on to the theory of Strato, the natural philosopher, who had observed that the amount of mud carried by rivers into the Euxine was so large that its bed must be gradually rising, while the rivers continued to bring in the same amount of water. Therefore, he proposed that, originally, when the Euxine was an inland sea, its level rose to the point where it broke through its barrier near Byzantium, creating a connection with the Propontis. He believed this partial drainage had already turned the left side into marshy land, and eventually, the entire area would be filled with soil. Thus, it was argued that the Mediterranean had once carved a path for itself through the Columns of Hercules into the Atlantic; and maybe the large number of sea shells in Africa, near the Temple of Jupiter Ammon, could be remnants of some former inland sea that ultimately found a way out.

15But Strabo rejects this theory, as insufficient to account for all the phenomena, and he proposes one of his own, the profoundness of which modern geologists are only beginning to appreciate. "It is not," he says, "because the lands covered by seas were originally at different altitudes, that the waters have risen, or subsided, or receded from some parts and inundated others. But the reason is, that the same land is sometimes raised up and sometimes depressed, and the sea also is simultaneously raised and depressed, so that it either overflows or returns into its own place again. We must, therefore, ascribe the cause to the ground, either to that ground which is under the sea, or to that which becomes flooded by it, but rather to that which lies beneath the sea, for this is more movable and, on account of its humidity, can be altered with greater celerity.27 "It is proper," he observes in continuation, "to derive our explanations from things which are obvious, and in some measure of daily occurrence, such as deluges, earthquakes, and volcanic eruptions,28 and sudden swellings of the land beneath the sea; for the last raise up the sea also; and when the same lands subside again, they occasion the sea to be let down. And it is not merely the small, but the large islands also, and not merely the islands, but the continents which can be lifted up together with the sea; and both large and small tracts may subside, for habitations and cities, like Bure, Bizona, and many others, have been engulphed by earthquakes."

15But Strabo dismisses this theory, saying it doesn’t explain everything, and he suggests one of his own, which modern geologists are only starting to recognize as significant. "It’s not," he says, "that the land that’s now underwater was originally at different heights that caused the waters to rise, fall, or flood some areas while receding from others. The real reason is that the same land can be pushed up or pulled down, and the sea can also rise or fall at the same time, so it either overflows or returns to where it was. We should attribute this cause to the land beneath the sea, or to the land that gets flooded, but more so to the ground under the sea, since it is more mobile and, due to its wetness, can change more quickly.27 "It’s important," he continues, "to base our explanations on things that are clear and happen regularly, like floods, earthquakes, volcanic eruptions,28 and sudden rises in the land under the sea; because these can raise the sea as well; and when that land sinks again, it causes the sea to lower. This affects not only small islands but also large ones, and not just islands, but entire continents can rise along with the sea; and both large and small areas can sink, since towns and cities, like Bure, Bizona, and many others, have been swallowed up by earthquakes."

In another place, this learned geographer, in alluding to the tradition that Sicily had been separated by a convulsion from Italy, remarks, that at present the land near the sea in those parts was rarely shaken by earthquakes, since there were now open orifices whereby fire and ignited matters, and waters escape; but formerly, when the volcanoes of Etna, the Lipari Islands, Ischia, and others, were closed up, the imprisoned fire and wind might have produced far more vehement movements.29 The doctrine, therefore, that volcanoes are safety-valves, and that the subterranean convulsions are probably most violent when first the volcanic energy shifts itself to a new quarter, is not modern.

In another location, this knowledgeable geographer mentions the belief that Sicily was separated from Italy due to a seismic event. He notes that currently, the coastal land in those areas rarely experiences earthquakes, as there are now openings for fire, molten material, and water to escape. However, in the past, when the volcanoes of Etna, the Lipari Islands, Ischia, and others were sealed shut, the trapped fire and wind could have caused much more intense movements.29 Therefore, the idea that volcanoes act as safety valves, and that underground convulsions are likely most violent when volcanic energy first shifts to a new location, is not a modern concept.

We learn from a passage in Strabo,30 that it was a dogma of the Gaulish Druids that the universe was immortal, but destined to survive catastrophes both of fire and water. That this doctrine was communicated to them from the East, with much of their learning, cannot be doubted. Cæsar, it will be remembered, says that they made use of Greek letters in arithmetical computations.31

We learn from a passage in Strabo,30 that the Gaulish Druids believed the universe was immortal, but destined to endure disasters from both fire and water. It's clear that this belief, along with much of their knowledge, was taught to them from the East. Cæsar noted that they used Greek letters for calculations.31

16Pliny.—This philosopher had no theoretical opinions of his own concerning changes of the earth's surface; and in this department, as in others, he restricted himself to the task of a compiler, without reasoning on the facts stated by him, or attempting to digest them into regular order. But his enumeration of the new islands which had been formed in the Mediterranean, and of other convulsions, shows that the ancients had not been inattentive observers of the changes which had taken place within the memory of man.

16Pliny.—This philosopher didn't have his own theoretical views on changes to the earth's surface; instead, like with other topics, he acted as a compiler. He didn’t analyze the facts he provided nor tried to organize them in a systematic way. However, his list of new islands formed in the Mediterranean and other upheavals demonstrates that ancient scholars were observant of the changes that occurred within living memory.

Such, then, appear to have been the opinions entertained before the Christian era, concerning the past revolutions of our globe. Although no particular investigations had been made for the express purpose of interpreting the monuments of ancient changes, they were too obvious to be entirely disregarded; and the observation of the present course of nature presented too many proofs of alterations continually in progress on the earth to allow philosophers to believe that nature was in a state of rest, or that the surface had remained, and would continue to remain unaltered. But they had never compared attentively the results of the destroying and reproductive operations of modern times with those of remote eras, nor had they ever entertained so much as a conjecture concerning the comparative antiquity of the human race, or of living species of animals and plants, with those belonging to former conditions of the organic world. They had studied the movements and positions of the heavenly bodies with laborious industry, and made some progress in investigating the animal, vegetable, and mineral kingdoms; but the ancient history of the globe was to them a sealed book, and, although written in characters of the most striking and imposing kind, they were unconscious even of its existence.

Such were the views held before the Christian era regarding the past changes of our planet. While no specific research had been conducted to interpret the signs of ancient transformations, they were too apparent to ignore. The observation of nature's ongoing processes provided too much evidence of constant changes taking place on Earth for philosophers to think that nature was at rest, or that the surface had stayed the same and would continue to do so. However, they never closely compared the results of the destructive and regenerative processes of recent times with those of distant eras, nor did they even consider the possibility of the relative age of humankind or the living species of plants and animals compared to those from earlier periods of the organic world. They studied the movements and positions of celestial bodies with great effort and made some advancements in exploring the animal, vegetable, and mineral realms, but the ancient history of the planet remained a mystery to them. Although it was written in the most striking and impressive signs, they were completely unaware of its existence.


CHAPTER III.

HISTORY OF THE PROGRESS OF GEOLOGY—continued.

Arabian writers of the tenth century—Avicenna—Omar—Cosmogony of the Koran—Kazwini—Early Italian writers—Leonardo da Vinci—Fracastoro—Controversy as to the real nature of fossils—Attributed to the Mosaic deluge— Palissy—Steno—Scilla—Quirini—Boyle—Lister—Leibnitz—Hooke's Theory of Elevation by Earthquakes—Of lost species of animals—Ray—Physico-theological writers—Woodward's Diluvial Theory—Burnet—Whiston—Vallisneri—Lazzaro Moro—Generelli—Buffon—His theory condemned by the Sorbonne as unorthodox—His declaration—Targioni—Arduino—Michell—Catcott—Raspe Fuchsel—Fortis—Testa—Whitehurst—Pallas—Saussure.

Arabian writers of the tenth century—Avicenna—Omar—The Cosmogony of the Koran—Kazwini—Early Italian writers—Leonardo da Vinci—Fracastoro—Debate about the true nature of fossils—Linked to the Mosaic flood—Palissy—Steno—Scilla—Quirini—Boyle—Lister—Leibnitz—Hooke's Theory of Elevation by Earthquakes—Lost animal species—Ray—Physico-theological writers—Woodward's Diluvial Theory—Burnet—Whiston—Vallisneri—Lazzaro Moro—Generelli—Buffon—His theory rejected by the Sorbonne as unorthodox—His statement—Targioni—Arduino—Michell—Catcott—Raspe Fuchsel—Fortis—Testa—Whitehurst—Pallas—Saussure.

Arabian writers.—After the decline of the Roman empire, the cultivation of physical science was first revived with some success by the Saracens, about the middle of the eighth century of our era. The works of the most eminent classic writers were purchased at great expense from the Christians, and translated into Arabic; and Al Mamûn, son of the famous Harûn-al-Rashid, the contemporary of Charlemagne, received with marks of distinction, at his court at Bagdad, astronomers and men of learning from different countries. This caliph, and some of his successors, encountered much opposition and jealousy from the doctors of the Mahometan law, who wished the Moslems to confine their studies to the Koran, dreading the effects of the diffusion of a taste for the physical sciences.32

Arabian writers.—After the fall of the Roman Empire, the study of physical science was first revived with some success by the Saracens around the middle of the eighth century. They bought the works of the most well-known classic writers at great cost from the Christians and translated them into Arabic. Al Mamûn, the son of the famous Harûn-al-Rashid and a contemporary of Charlemagne, welcomed astronomers and scholars from various countries to his court in Baghdad with great honor. This caliph, along with some of his successors, faced considerable opposition and jealousy from the doctors of Islamic law, who wanted Muslims to limit their studies to the Koran, fearing the impact of spreading interest in the physical sciences.32

Avicenna.—Almost all the works of the early Arabian writers are lost. Amongst those of the tenth century, of which fragments are now extant, is a short treatise, "On the Formation and Classification of Minerals," by Avicenna, a physician, in whose arrangement there is considerable merit. The second chapter, "On the Cause of Mountains," is remarkable; for mountains, he says, are formed, some by essential, others by accidental causes. In illustration of the essential, he instances "a violent earthquake, by which land is elevated, and becomes a mountain;" of the accidental, the principal, he says, is excavation by water, whereby cavities are produced, and adjoining lands made to stand out and form eminences.33

Avicenna.—Almost all the works of early Arabian writers are lost. Among those from the tenth century, of which fragments still exist, is a short treatise called "On the Formation and Classification of Minerals" by Avicenna, a physician, which has considerable merit in its organization. The second chapter, "On the Cause of Mountains," is notable; he explains that mountains are created by both essential and accidental causes. To illustrate the essential cause, he mentions "a violent earthquake that lifts land and creates a mountain"; for the accidental cause, he says the main factor is water excavation, which creates cavities and causes surrounding land to rise and form peaks.33

Omar—Cosmogony of the Koran.—In the same century, also, Omar, surnamed "El Aalem," or "The Learned," wrote a work on "The Retreat of the Sea." It appears that on comparing the charts of his own time with those made by the Indian and Persian astronomers two thousand years before, he had satisfied himself that important changes had taken place since the times of history in the form of the coasts of Asia, 18and that the extension of the sea had been greater at some former periods. He was confirmed in this opinion by the numerous salt springs and marshes in the interior of Asia,—a phenomenon from which Pallas, in more recent times, has drawn the same inference.

Omar—Cosmogony of the Koran.—In the same century, Omar, nicknamed "El Aalem," or "The Learned," wrote a book called "The Retreat of the Sea." He seemed to conclude that when he compared the maps from his time with those created by Indian and Persian astronomers two thousand years earlier, significant changes had occurred in the coastal layout of Asia, 18 and that the sea had covered a larger area in earlier periods. He was supported in this view by the many salt springs and marshes found in the interior of Asia—a phenomenon from which Pallas, in more recent times, has drawn a similar conclusion.

Von Hoff has suggested, with great probability, that the changes in the level of the Caspian (some of which there is reason to believe have happened within the historical era), and the geological appearances in that district, indicating the desertion by that sea of its ancient bed, had probably led Omar to his theory of a general subsidence. But whatever may have been the proofs relied on, his system was declared contradictory to certain passages in the Koran, and he was called upon publicly to recant his errors; to avoid which persecution he went into voluntary banishment from Samarkand.34

Von Hoff has likely suggested that the changes in the level of the Caspian Sea (some of which probably occurred during historical times) and the geological features in that area, showing that the sea abandoned its old bed, may have influenced Omar's theory of a general subsidence. However, regardless of the evidence he relied on, his theory was considered contradictory to certain verses in the Koran, and he was publicly pressured to retract his mistakes. To escape this persecution, he chose to voluntarily exile himself from Samarkand.34

The cosmological opinions expressed in the Koran are few, and merely introduced incidentally: so that it is not easy to understand how they could have interfered so seriously with free discussion on the former changes of the globe. The Prophet declares that the earth was created in two days, and the mountains were then placed on it; and during these, and two additional days, the inhabitants of the earth were formed; and in two more the seven heavens.35 There is no more detail of circumstances; and the deluge, which is also mentioned, is discussed with equal brevity. The waters are represented to have poured out of an oven; a strange fable, said to be borrowed from the Persian Magi, who represented them as issuing from the oven of an old woman.36 All men were drowned, save Noah and his family; and then God said, "O earth, swallow up thy waters; and thou, O heaven, withhold thy rain;" and immediately the waters abated.37

The cosmological views found in the Quran are limited and mostly mentioned in passing, making it hard to see how they could have significantly affected open discussions about the planet's earlier changes. The Prophet states that the earth was created in two days, and then mountains were placed on it; during these days, and in two more, the inhabitants of the earth were formed, followed by the creation of the seven heavens in another two days.35 There are no further details provided; even the flood, which is also referenced, is addressed briefly. The waters are described as coming out of an oven, a peculiar story believed to be taken from the Persian Magi, who depicted the waters as coming from an old woman's oven.36 Everyone drowned except for Noah and his family; then God commanded, "O earth, swallow up your waters; and you, O heaven, hold back your rain;" and right away, the waters receded.37

We may suppose Omar to have represented the desertion of the land by the sea to have been gradual, and that his hypothesis required a greater lapse of ages than was consistent with Moslem orthodoxy; for it is to be inferred from the Koran, that man and this planet were created at the same time; and although Mahomet did not limit expressly the antiquity of the human race, yet he gave an implied sanction to the Mosaic chronology, by the veneration expressed by him for the Hebrew Patriarchs.38

We can assume that Omar believed the land was slowly being abandoned by the sea, and that his theory needed a longer period of time than what was acceptable to Muslim beliefs; because it's suggested in the Koran that humans and the Earth were created simultaneously. Although Muhammad didn't specifically set limits on how long humans have existed, he indirectly supported the timeline from the Bible by showing respect for the Hebrew Patriarchs.38

19A manuscript work, entitled the "Wonders of Nature," is preserved in the Royal Library at Paris, by an Arabian writer, Mohammed Kazwini, who flourished in the seventh century of the Hegira, or at the close of the thirteenth century of our era.39 Besides several curious remarks on aerolites, earthquakes, and the successive changes of position which the land and sea have undergone, we meet with the following beautiful passage which is given as the narrative of Kidhz, an allegorical personage:—"I passed one day by a very ancient and wonderfully populous city, and asked one of its inhabitants how long it had been founded. 'It is indeed a mighty city,' replied he; 'we know not how long it has existed, and our ancestors were on this subject as ignorant as ourselves.' Five centuries afterwards, as I passed by the same place, I could not perceive the slightest vestige of the city. I demanded of a peasant, who was gathering herbs upon its former site, how long it had been destroyed. 'In sooth a strange question!' replied he. 'The ground here has never been different from what you now behold it.'—'Was there not of old,' said I, 'a splendid city here?'—'Never,' answered he, 'so far as we have seen, and never did our fathers speak to us of any such.' On my return there 500 years afterwards, I found the sea in the same place, and on its shores were a party of fishermen, of whom I inquired how long the land had been covered by the waters? 'Is this a question,' said they, 'for a man like you? this spot has always been what it is now.' I again returned, 500 years afterwards, and the sea had disappeared; I inquired of a man who stood alone upon the spot, how long ago this change had taken place, and he gave me the same answer as I had received before. Lastly, on coming back again after an equal lapse of time, I found there a flourishing city, more populous and more rich in beautiful buildings, than the city I had seen the first time, and when I would fain have informed myself concerning its origin, the inhabitants answered me, 'Its rise is lost in remote antiquity: we are ignorant how long it has existed, and our fathers were on this subject as ignorant as ourselves.'"

19A manuscript titled "Wonders of Nature" is kept in the Royal Library in Paris, written by an Arabian author, Mohammed Kazwini, who lived in the seventh century of the Hegira, or at the end of the thirteenth century of our era.39 In addition to some interesting comments about meteorites, earthquakes, and the various changes in the land and sea, there's a beautiful passage that tells the story of Kidhz, an allegorical figure:—"One day, I walked by a very old and incredibly crowded city, and I asked one of its residents how long it had been established. 'It is indeed a great city,' he replied; 'we don’t know how long it has existed, and our ancestors knew just as little as we do.' Five centuries later, as I passed the same place, there was not a trace of the city left. I asked a farmer, who was picking herbs on its former site, how long it had been gone. 'That's a strange question!' he said. 'The ground here has always looked like what you see now.'—'Wasn't there a magnificent city here long ago?' I asked.—'Never,' he answered, 'as far as we know, and our fathers never told us about any such place.' When I returned 500 years later, I found the sea in the same location, and on the shores were a group of fishermen. I asked them how long the land had been underwater. 'Is that a question for someone like you?' they replied. 'This spot has always been like it is now.' I came back again 500 years later, and the sea had vanished; I asked a man standing alone at that spot how long ago this change occurred, and he gave me the same answer I had heard before. Finally, after the same amount of time, I returned to find a thriving city, more populated and wealthier in beautiful buildings than the one I had seen before, and when I tried to learn about its origins, the people told me, 'Its beginnings are lost in ancient times: we don’t know how long it has existed, and our fathers were just as clueless as we are.'"

Early Italian writers.—It was not till the earlier part of the sixteenth century that geological phenomena began to attract the attention of the Christian nations. At that period a very animated controversy sprang up in Italy, concerning the true nature and origin of marine shells, and other organized fossils, found abundantly in the strata of the peninsula. The celebrated painter Leonardo da Vinci, who in his youth had planned and executed some navigable canals in the north of Italy, was one of the first who applied sound reasoning to these subjects. The mud of rivers, he said, had covered and penetrated into the interior of fossil shells at a time when these were still at the bottom of the sea near the coast. "They tell us that these shells were formed in the 20hills by the influence of the stars; but I ask where in the hills are the stars now forming shells of distinct ages and species? and how can the stars explain the origin of gravel, occurring at different heights and composed of pebbles rounded as if by the motion of running water; or in what manner can such a cause account for the petrifaction in the same places of various leaves, sea-weeds, and marine-crabs?"40

Early Italian writers.—It wasn't until the early part of the sixteenth century that geological phenomena started to get the attention of Christian nations. During that time, a lively debate emerged in Italy about the true nature and origin of marine shells and other fossilized remains found abundantly in the layers of the peninsula. The famous painter Leonardo da Vinci, who had planned and built some navigable canals in northern Italy when he was younger, was one of the first to apply sound reasoning to these issues. He stated that river mud had covered and infiltrated fossil shells when they were still at the bottom of the sea near the coast. "People say that these shells were formed in the hills by the influence of the stars; but I ask, where in the hills are the stars currently forming shells of different ages and types? And how can the stars explain the origin of gravel, which occurs at various heights and is composed of pebbles rounded as if by the movement of flowing water? Or how can such a cause account for the petrifaction of various leaves, seaweeds, and marine crabs in the same locations?"40

The excavations made in 1517, for repairing the city of Verona, brought to light a multitude of curious petrifactions, and furnished matter for speculation to different authors, and among the rest to Fracastoro,41 who declared his opinion, that fossil shells had all belonged to living animals, which had formerly lived and multiplied where there exuviæ are now found. He exposed the absurdity of having recourse to a certain "plastic force," which it was said had power to fashion stones into organic forms; and with no less cogent arguments, demonstrated the futility of attributing the situation of the shells in question to the Mosaic deluge, a theory obstinately defended by some. That inundation, he observed, was too transient; it consisted principally of fluviatile waters; and if it had transported shells to great distances, must have strewed them over the surface, not buried them at vast depths in the interior of mountains. His clear exposition of the evidence would have terminated the discussion forever, if the passions of mankind had not been enlisted in the dispute; and even though doubts should for a time have remained in some minds, they would speedily have been removed by the fresh information obtained almost immediately afterwards, respecting the structure of fossil remains, and of their living analogues.

The excavations in 1517, to repair the city of Verona, uncovered a wealth of intriguing fossils and sparked speculation among various authors, including Fracastoro,41 who expressed his belief that fossil shells all came from living animals that once thrived and reproduced where their remains are now found. He pointed out the ridiculousness of invoking a so-called "plastic force" that was thought to shape stones into organic forms; and with equally strong arguments, he demonstrated the absurdity of linking the placement of these shells to the Biblical flood, a theory stubbornly defended by some. He noted that the flood was too brief; it largely consisted of river waters, and if it had carried shells over great distances, they would have been spread across the surface, not buried deep within mountains. His clear presentation of the evidence could have ended the debate for good, if not for the strong emotions people had about the issue; and even if some doubts lingered initially, they would soon be cleared up by new information that became available shortly afterward about the structure of fossil remains and their living counterparts.

But the clear and philosophical views of Fracastoro were disregarded, and the talent and argumentative powers of the learned were doomed for three centuries to be wasted in the discussion of these two simple and preliminary questions: first, whether fossil remains had ever belonged to living creatures; and, secondly, whether, if this be admitted, all the phenomena could not be explained by the deluge of Noah. It had been the general belief of the Christian world down to the period now under consideration, that the origin of this planet was not more remote than a few thousand years; and that since the creation the deluge was the only great catastrophe by which considerable change had been wrought on the earth's surface. On the other hand, the opinion was scarcely less general, that the final dissolution of our system was an event to be looked for at no distant period. The era, it is true, of the expected millennium had passed away; and for five hundred years after the fatal hour when the annihilation of the planet 21had been looked for, the monks remained in undisturbed enjoyment of rich grants of land bequeathed to them by pious donors, who, in the preamble of deeds beginning "appropinquante mundi termino"——"appropinquante magno judicii die," left lasting monuments of the popular delusion.42

But the clear and philosophical ideas of Fracastoro were ignored, and the skills and debating abilities of scholars were wasted for three centuries discussing two simple and basic questions: first, whether fossil remains ever belonged to living creatures; and, second, whether, if this is accepted, all the phenomena could be explained by Noah's flood. It had been widely believed in the Christian world up to this time that the origin of the planet was only a few thousand years old; and that since creation, the flood was the only major disaster that had significantly changed the earth’s surface. On the other hand, it was almost equally believed that the final destruction of our system was something to expect in the near future. It is true that the anticipated millennium had come and gone; and for five hundred years after the fateful moment when the destruction of the planet was expected, monks enjoyed their rich land grants left to them by pious donors, who, in the preambles of deeds starting with "appropinquante mundi termino"——"appropinquante magno judicii die," created lasting reminders of the widespread delusion. 2142

But although in the sixteenth century it had become necessary to interpret certain prophecies respecting the millennium more liberally, and to assign a more distant date to the future conflagration of the world, we find, in the speculations of the early geologists, perpetual allusion to such an approaching catastrophe; while in all that regarded the antiquity of the earth, no modification whatever of the opinions of the dark ages had been effected. Considerable alarm was at first excited when the attempt was made to invalidate, by physical proofs, an article of faith so generally received; but there was sufficient spirit of toleration and candor amongst the Italian ecclesiastics, to allow the subject to be canvassed with much freedom. They even entered warmly into the controversy themselves, often favoring different sides of the question; and however much we may deplore the loss of time and labor devoted to the defence of untenable positions, it must be conceded that they displayed far less polemic bitterness than certain writers who followed them "beyond the Alps," two centuries and a half later.

But even though, in the sixteenth century, it became necessary to interpret certain prophecies about the millennium more loosely and to push back the date for the future destruction of the world, we still see early geologists constantly alluding to such an impending catastrophe. Meanwhile, when it came to the age of the Earth, there was no change at all in the beliefs from the dark ages. There was quite a bit of alarm at first when someone tried to challenge such a widely accepted belief with physical evidence; however, the Italian clergy had enough tolerance and openness to allow the topic to be discussed quite freely. They even engaged passionately in the debate themselves, often supporting different sides of the argument. And while we might regret the time and effort spent defending unsupported views, we must acknowledge that they showed far less argumentative hostility than some writers who came after them "beyond the Alps" two and a half centuries later.

CONTROVERSY AS TO THE REAL NATURE OF FOSSIL ORGANIC REMAINS.

Mattioli—Falloppio.—The system of scholastic disputations, encouraged in the universities of the middle ages, had unfortunately trained men to habits of indefinite argumentation; and they often preferred absurd and extravagant propositions, because greater skill was required to maintain them; the end and object of these intellectual combats being victory, and not truth. No theory could be so far-fetched or fantastical as not to attract some followers, provided it fell in with popular notions; and as cosmogonists were not at all restricted, in building their systems, to the agency of known causes, the opponents of Fracastoro met his arguments by feigning imaginary causes, which differed from each other rather in name than in substance. Andrea Mattioli, for instance, an eminent botanist, the illustrator of Dioscorides, embraced the notion of Agricola, a skilful German miner, that a certain "materia pinguis," or "fatty matter," set into fermentation by heat, gave birth to fossil organic shapes. Yet Mattioli had come to the conclusion, from his own observations, that porous bodies, such as bones and shells, might be converted into stone, as being permeable to what he termed the "lapidifying juice." In like manner, Falloppio of Padua conceived that petrified shells were generated by fermentation in the spots where they are found, or that they had in some cases acquired 22their form from "the tumultuous movements of terrestrial exhalations." Although celebrated as a professor of anatomy, he taught that certain tusks of elephants, dug up in his time in Apulia, were mere earthy concretions; and, consistently with these principles, he even went so far as to consider it probable, that the vases of Monte Testaceo at Rome were natural impressions stamped in the soil.43 In the same spirit, Mercati, who published, in 1574, faithful figures of the fossil shells preserved by Pope Sixtus V. in the Museum of the Vatican, expressed an opinion that they were mere stones, which had assumed their peculiar configuration from the influence of the heavenly bodies; and Olivi of Cremona, who described the fossil remains of a rich museum at Verona, was satisfied with considering them as mere "sports of nature."

Mattioli—Falloppio.—The system of scholarly debates, promoted in the universities during the Middle Ages, unfortunately trained people to engage in endless arguments; they often favored ridiculous and outlandish claims because it required more skill to defend them. The goal of these intellectual duels was victory, not truth. No theory was too far-fetched or bizarre to attract some adherents, as long as it aligned with popular beliefs. Since cosmologists were not limited, in creating their theories, to the influence of known causes, Fracastoro’s opponents countered his arguments by inventing imaginary causes, which varied more in name than in essence. For instance, Andrea Mattioli, a prominent botanist who illustrated Dioscorides, accepted Agricola’s idea, a skilled German miner, that a certain "materia pinguis," or "fatty matter," when fermented by heat, gave rise to fossilized organic shapes. However, Mattioli concluded from his observations that porous materials, like bones and shells, could turn into stone because they absorbed what he called the "lapidifying juice." Similarly, Falloppio of Padua believed that petrified shells formed through fermentation at their locations or that, in some cases, they got their shapes from "the tumultuous movements of terrestrial exhalations." Although he was well-known as a professor of anatomy, he claimed that certain elephant tusks uncovered in Apulia during his time were simply earthy concretions; consistent with these ideas, he even suggested that the vases from Monte Testaceo in Rome were natural impressions in the soil.22 In the same vein, Mercati, who published accurate illustrations of the fossil shells kept by Pope Sixtus V. in the Vatican Museum in 1574, argued that they were just stones that had taken on their unique shapes due to the influence of celestial bodies; meanwhile, Olivi of Cremona, who documented the fossil remains in a rich museum at Verona, was content to regard them as mere "sports of nature."

Some of the fanciful notions of those times were deemed less unreasonable, as being somewhat in harmony with the Aristotelian theory of spontaneous generation, then taught in all the schools.44 For men who had been taught in early youth, that a large proportion of living animals and plants was formed from the fortuitous concourse of atoms, or had sprung from the corruption of organic matter, might easily persuade themselves that organic shapes, often imperfectly preserved in the interior of solid rocks, owed their existence to causes equally obscure and mysterious.

Some of the imaginative ideas from that time were considered less crazy, as they aligned somewhat with the Aristotelian theory of spontaneous generation, which was taught in all the schools.44 For men who had been taught from a young age that a significant number of living animals and plants came from random arrangements of atoms, or had emerged from the decay of organic matter, it was easy for them to believe that organic shapes, often poorly preserved inside solid rocks, resulted from equally obscure and mysterious causes.

Cardano, 1552.—But there were not wanting some who, during the progress of this century, expressed more sound and sober opinions. The title of a work of Cardano's, published in 1552, "De Subtilitate" (corresponding to what would now be called Transcendental Philosophy), would lead us to expect, in the chapter on minerals, many far-fetched theories characteristic of that age; but when treating of petrified shells, he decided that they clearly indicated the former sojourn of the sea upon the mountains.45

Cardano, 1552.—However, there were some who, during this century, shared more reasonable and sensible views. The title of a work by Cardano, published in 1552, "De Subtilitate" (which would now be referred to as Transcendental Philosophy), suggests that we might expect to find many convoluted theories typical of that time in the chapter about minerals; but when he discussed petrified shells, he concluded that they clearly indicated the past presence of the sea on the mountains.45

Cesalpino—Majoli, 1597.—Cesalpino, a celebrated botanist, conceived that fossil shells had been left on the land by the retiring sea, and had concreted into stone during the consolidation of the soil;46 and in the following year (1597), Simeone Majoli47 went still farther; and, coinciding for the most part with the views of Cesalpino, suggested that the shells and submarine matter of the Veronese, and other districts, might have been cast up upon the land by volcanic explosions, like those which gave rise, in 1538, to Monte Nuovo, near Puzzuoli. This hint seems to have been the first imperfect attempt to connect the position of fossil shells with the agency of volcanoes, a system afterwards more fully developed by Hooke, Lazzaro Moro, Hutton, and other writers.

Cesalpino—Majoli, 1597.—Cesalpino, a famous botanist, thought that fossil shells had been left on land by the receding sea and had turned into stone as the soil consolidated;46 and the next year (1597), Simeone Majoli47 took things further. Agreeing largely with Cesalpino’s ideas, he proposed that the shells and underwater materials from Verona and other areas might have been pushed onto land by volcanic eruptions, similar to those that created Monte Nuovo near Puzzuoli in 1538. This suggestion seems to have been the first early attempt to link the location of fossil shells with volcanic activity, a theory that was later expanded upon by Hooke, Lazzaro Moro, Hutton, and others.

Two years afterwards, Imperati advocated the animal origin of fossilized shells, yet admitted that stones could vegetate by force of "an internal principle;" and, as evidence of this, he referred to the teeth of fish and spines of echini found petrified.48

Two years later, Imperati supported the idea that fossilized shells came from animals but acknowledged that stones could grow due to "an internal principle." As proof of this, he pointed to the teeth of fish and spines of sea urchins that had turned to stone.48

23Palissy, 1580.—Palissy, a French writer on "The Origin of Springs from Rain-water," and of other scientific works, undertook, in 1580, to combat the notions of many of his contemporaries in Italy, that petrified shells had all been deposited by the universal deluge. "He was the first," said Fontenelle, when, in the French Academy, he pronounced his eulogy, nearly a century and a half later, "who dared assert," in Paris, that fossil remains of testacea and fish had once belonged to marine animals.

23Palissy, 1580.—Palissy, a French writer on "The Origin of Springs from Rain-water" and other scientific works, set out in 1580 to challenge the beliefs of many of his contemporaries in Italy who thought that petrified shells were all left behind by the great flood. "He was the first," said Fontenelle when he delivered his eulogy in the French Academy nearly a century and a half later, "who dared to claim," in Paris, that fossil remains of shellfish and fish had once belonged to marine animals.

Fabio Colonna.—To enumerate the multitude of Italian writers, who advanced various hypotheses, all equally fantastical, in the early part of the seventeenth century, would be unprofitably tedious; but Fabio Colonna deserves to be distinguished; for, although he gave way to the dogma, that all fossil remains were to be referred to the deluge of Noah, he resisted the absurd theory of Stelluti, who taught that fossil wood and ammonites were mere clay, altered into such forms by sulphureous waters and subterranean heat; and he pointed out the different states of shells buried in the strata, distinguishing between, first, the mere mould or impression; second, the cast or nucleus; and, thirdly, the remains of the shell itself. He had also the merit of being the first to point out that some of the fossils had belonged to marine and some to terrestrial testacea.49

Fabio Colonna.—Listing the many Italian writers who proposed various theories, all equally far-fetched, in the early seventeenth century would be unnecessarily tedious; however, Fabio Colonna deserves special mention. Although he accepted the belief that all fossil remains were connected to Noah’s flood, he rejected the ridiculous theory of Stelluti, who claimed that fossilized wood and ammonites were just clay transformed into those shapes by sulfurous waters and underground heat. He noted the different conditions of shells found in the layers of earth, categorizing them into three types: first, the mere mold or impression; second, the cast or core; and third, the actual remains of the shell. He was also the first to point out that some fossils belonged to marine creatures while others belonged to land-dwelling mollusks.49

Steno, 1669.—But the most remarkable work of that period was published by Steno, a Dane, once professor of anatomy at Padua, and who afterwards resided many years at the court of the Grand Duke of Tuscany. His treatise bears the quaint title of "De Solido intra Solidum naturaltier contento (1669)," by which the author intended to express, "On Gems, Crystals, and organic Petrifactions inclosed within solid Rocks." This work attests the priority of the Italian school in geological research; exemplifying at the same time the powerful obstacles opposed, in that age, to the general reception of enlarged views in the science. It was still a favorite dogma, that the fossil remains of shells and marine creatures were not of animal origin; an opinion adhered to by many from their extreme reluctance to believe, that the earth could have been inhabited by living beings before a great part of the existing mountains were formed. In reference to this controversy, Steno had dissected a shark recently taken from the Mediterranean, and had demonstrated that its teeth and bones were identical with many fossils found in Tuscany. He had also compared the shells discovered in the Italian strata with living species, pointed out their resemblance, and traced the various gradations from shells merely calcined, or which had only lost their animal gluten, to those petrifactions in which there was a perfect substitution of stony matter. In his division of mineral masses, he insisted on the secondary origin of those deposits in which the spoils of animals or fragments of older rocks were inclosed. He distinguished between marine formations and those of a fluviatile character, 24the last containing reeds, grasses, or the trunks and branches of trees. He argued in favor of the original horizontality of sedimentary deposits, attributing their present inclined and vertical position sometimes to the escape of subterranean vapors heaving the crust of the earth from below upwards, and sometimes to the falling in of masses overlying subterranean cavities.

Steno, 1669.—The most notable work from that time was published by Steno, a Dane who was once a professor of anatomy at Padua and later spent many years at the court of the Grand Duke of Tuscany. His treatise has the unusual title "De Solido intra Solidum naturaltier contento (1669)," which he meant to convey, "On Gems, Crystals, and Organic Petrifactions Enclosed within Solid Rocks." This work highlights the early contributions of the Italian school to geological research; at the same time, it illustrates the significant challenges faced during that era in gaining acceptance for broader ideas in the science. It was still widely believed that fossilized remains of shells and marine creatures were not of animal origin; many held onto this view due to their strong reluctance to accept that the Earth could have been home to living beings before much of the current mountain ranges were formed. In light of this debate, Steno dissected a shark recently caught in the Mediterranean and showed that its teeth and bones matched many fossils found in Tuscany. He also compared shells found in Italian strata with living species, noted their similarities, and outlined the various stages from shells that were simply calcined or had just lost their animal matter, to those petrifactions where there was a complete replacement of stony material. In his classification of mineral formations, he emphasized the secondary origin of those deposits that contained remains of animals or fragments of older rocks. He differentiated between marine formations and those of a riverine nature, with the latter including reeds, grasses, and the trunks and branches of trees. He argued for the original horizontal nature of sedimentary deposits, suggesting that their current tilted and vertical positions were sometimes caused by subterranean vapors pushing the Earth's crust upward, and other times by the collapse of layers above underground cavities. 24

He declared that he had obtained proof that Tuscany must successively have acquired six distinct configurations, having been twice covered by water, twice laid dry with a level, and twice with an irregular and uneven surface.50 He displayed great anxiety to reconcile his new views with Scripture, for which purpose he pointed to certain rocks as having been formed before the existence of animals and plants: selecting unfortunately as examples certain formations of limestone and sandstone in his own country, now known to contain, though sparingly, the remains of animals and plants,—strata which do not even rank as the oldest part of our secondary series. Steno suggested that Moses, when speaking of the loftiest mountains as having been covered by the deluge, meant merely the loftiest of the hills then existing, which may not have been very high. The diluvian waters, he supposed, may have issued from the interior of the earth into which they had retired, when in the beginning the land was separated from the sea. These, and other hypotheses on the same subject, are not calculated to enhance the value of the treatise, and could scarcely fail to detract from the authority of those opinions which were sound and legitimate deductions from fact and observation. They have served, nevertheless, as the germs of many popular theories of later times, and in an expanded form have been put forth as original inventions by some of our contemporaries.

He stated that he had proof that Tuscany must have gone through six different forms, having been covered by water twice, dried out flat twice, and had an uneven surface twice.50 He was very eager to align his new ideas with Scripture, so he pointed to certain rocks that he claimed were formed before animals and plants existed: unfortunately, he chose limestone and sandstone formations in his own country, which are now known to contain, although sparingly, the remains of animals and plants—layers that aren’t even the oldest in our secondary series. Steno suggested that when Moses talked about the highest mountains being covered by the flood, he was referring to the highest hills that existed at the time, which may not have been very tall. He theorized that the floodwaters might have come from deep within the earth, which had receded when land was first separated from the sea. These and other theories on the same topic don’t add much value to the treatise and could diminish the credibility of those opinions that were based on solid facts and observations. Nonetheless, they have become the foundation for many popular theories later on and have been presented as original ideas by some of our contemporaries.

Scilla, 1670.—Scilla, a Sicilian painter, published, in 1670, a treatise, in Latin, on the fossils of Calabria, illustrated by good engravings. This work proves the continued ascendancy of dogmas often refuted; for we find the wit and eloquence of the author chiefly directed against the obstinate incredulity of naturalists as to the organic nature of fossil shells.51 Like many eminent naturalists of his day, Scilla gave way to the popular persuasion, that all fossil shells were the effects and proofs of the Mosaic deluge. It may be doubted whether he was perfectly sincere, and some of his contemporaries who took the same course were certainly not so. But so eager were they to root out what they justly considered an absurd prejudice respecting the nature of organized fossils, that they seem to have been ready to make any concessions, in order to establish this preliminary point. Such a compromising policy was short-sighted, since it was to little purpose that the nature of the documents should at 25length be correctly understood, if men were to be prevented from deducing fair conclusions from them.

Scilla, 1670.—Scilla, a Sicilian painter, published a treatise in Latin in 1670 on the fossils of Calabria, complete with good illustrations. This work highlights the persistence of beliefs that have often been challenged; the author focuses his wit and eloquence mainly against the stubborn disbelief of naturalists regarding the organic nature of fossil shells.51 Like many prominent naturalists of his time, Scilla succumbed to the popular belief that all fossil shells were a result of the Mosaic flood. It's questionable whether he was completely sincere, and some of his contemporaries who followed the same path certainly were not. However, they were so eager to eliminate what they rightly viewed as a ridiculous bias concerning organized fossils that they appeared willing to make any compromises to establish this fundamental point. This compromising approach was shortsighted, since it was pointless for the actual nature of the evidence to be properly understood if people were prevented from drawing valid conclusions from it.

Diluvial Theory.—The theologians who now entered the field in Italy, Germany, France, and England, were innumerable; and henceforward, they who refused to subscribe to the position, that all marine organic remains were proofs of the Mosaic deluge, were exposed to the imputation of disbelieving the whole of the sacred writings. Scarcely any step had been made in approximating to sound theories since the time of Fracastoro, more than a hundred years having been lost, in writing down the dogma that organized fossils were mere sports of nature. An additional period of a century and a half was now destined to be consumed in exploding the hypothesis, that organized fossils had all been buried in the solid strata by Noah's flood. Never did a theoretical fallacy, in any branch of science, interfere more seriously with accurate observation and the systematic classification of facts. In recent times, we may attribute our rapid progress chiefly to the careful determination of the order of succession in mineral masses, by means of their different organic contents, and their regular superposition. But the old diluvialists were induced by their system to confound all the groups of strata together instead of discriminating,—to refer all appearances to one cause and to one brief period, not to a variety of causes acting throughout a long succession of epochs. They saw the phenomena only as they desired to see them, sometimes misrepresenting facts, and at other times deducing false conclusions from correct data. Under the influence of such prejudices, three centuries were of as little avail as a few years in our own times, when we are no longer required to propel the vessel against the force of an adverse current.

Diluvial Theory.—The theologians who entered the debate in Italy, Germany, France, and England were countless. From this point on, anyone who refused to accept the idea that all marine organic remains were evidence of the Biblical flood risked being labeled as disbelievers in the entire sacred text. Little progress had been made toward developing sound theories since Fracastoro's time, with over a hundred years wasted insisting that organized fossils were just random occurrences in nature. Another century and a half would now be wasted trying to disprove the theory that organized fossils were buried in solid layers by Noah's flood. No theoretical mistake in any field of science has obstructed accurate observation and the systematic classification of facts more seriously. Recently, we can credit our rapid advancements mainly to the careful analysis of the sequence of mineral layers based on their various organic contents and their consistent stacking. However, the old diluvialists, driven by their beliefs, blurred the distinctions between different strata groups instead of identifying them, attributing all findings to one cause and a brief time frame, rather than recognizing the many causes that acted over a long series of epochs. They perceived the phenomena only as they wanted to, occasionally misrepresenting facts and sometimes drawing incorrect conclusions from accurate data. Influenced by such biases, three centuries were as ineffective as just a few years in our time, when we no longer have to push against the tide of opposing currents.

It may be well, therefore, to forewarn the reader, that in tracing the history of geology from the close of the seventeenth to the end of the eighteenth century, he must expect to be occupied with accounts of the retardation, as well as of the advance, of the science. It will be necessary to point out the frequent revival of exploded errors, and the relapse from sound to the most absurd opinions; and to dwell on futile reasoning and visionary hypothesis, because some of the most extravagant systems were invented or controverted by men of acknowledged talent. In short, a sketch of the progress of geology is the history of a constant and violent struggle of new opinions against doctrines sanctioned by the implicit faith of many generations, and supposed to rest on scriptural authority. The inquiry, therefore, although highly interesting to one who studies the philosophy of the human mind, is too often barren of instruction to him who searches for truths in physical science.

It might be helpful to warn the reader that when looking back at the history of geology from the late seventeenth century to the end of the eighteenth century, they should be prepared to see both setbacks and progress in the field. It will be important to highlight the frequent reemergence of outdated ideas and the regression from sound theories to the most ridiculous beliefs. We will also need to focus on pointless reasoning and fanciful hypotheses, since some of the most outrageous theories were proposed or challenged by genuinely talented individuals. In short, an overview of geology's development is essentially a history of a continuous and intense battle between new ideas and established beliefs that have been accepted without question for many generations, and which were thought to be supported by biblical authority. Therefore, while this investigation is highly engaging for those who explore the philosophy of the human mind, it often lacks valuable insights for those seeking truths in physical science.

Quirini, 1676.—Quirini, in 1676,52 contended, in opposition to Scilla, that the diluvian waters could not have conveyed heavy bodies to the summit of mountains, since the agitation of the sea never (as Boyle had 26demonstrated) extended to great depths;53 and still less could the testacea, as some pretended, have lived in these diluvian waters; for "the duration of the flood was brief, and the heavy rains must have destroyed the saltness of the sea!" He was the first writer who ventured to maintain that the universality of the Mosaic cataclysm ought not to be insisted upon. As to the nature of petrified shells, he conceived that as earthy particles united in the sea to form the shells of mollusca, the same crystallizing process might be effected on the land; and that, in the latter case, the germs of the animals might have been disseminated through the substance of the rocks, and afterwards developed by virtue of humidity. Visionary as was this doctrine, it gained many proselytes even amongst the more sober reasoners of Italy and Germany; for it conceded that the position of fossil bodies could not be accounted for by the diluvial theory.

Quirini, 1676.—In 1676, Quirini argued against Scilla that the floodwaters couldn't have carried heavy objects to the tops of mountains because, as Boyle demonstrated, the agitation of the sea didn't reach great depths. Furthermore, he claimed that the testacea couldn’t have survived in those floodwaters, stating, "the flood lasted a short time, and the heavy rains must have ruined the sea’s saltiness!" He was the first writer to assert that the universality of the Mosaic flood shouldn’t be insisted upon. Regarding the nature of petrified shells, he theorized that just as earthy particles came together in the sea to form mollusk shells, a similar crystallization process could occur on land. In this case, the animal germs might have spread through the rocks and then developed due to moisture. Though this idea was regarded as fanciful, it attracted many followers among even the more rational thinkers in Italy and Germany, as it acknowledged that the arrangement of fossil bodies couldn't be explained by the flood theory.

Plot—Lister, 1678.—In the mean time, the doctrine that fossil shells had never belonged to real animals maintained its ground in England, where the agitation of the question began at a much later period. Dr. Plot, in his "Natural History of Oxfordshire" (1677), attributed to a "plastic virtue latent in the earth" the origin of fossil shells and fishes; and Lister, to his accurate account of British shells, in 1678, added the fossil species, under the appellation of turbinated and bivalve stones. "Either," said he, "these were terriginous, or, if otherwise, the animals they so exactly represent have become extinct." This writer appears to have been the first who was aware of the continuity over large districts of the principal groups of strata in the British series, and who proposed the construction of regular geological maps.54

Plot—Lister, 1678.—Meanwhile, the belief that fossil shells never belonged to real animals continued to be upheld in England, where the debate on the matter started much later. Dr. Plot, in his "Natural History of Oxfordshire" (1677), attributed the origin of fossil shells and fish to a "plastic virtue latent in the earth"; and Lister, in 1678, added fossil species to his precise account of British shells, referring to them as turbinated and bivalve stones. "Either," he stated, "these were terrigenous, or, if not, the animals they so accurately represent have become extinct." This writer seems to have been the first to recognize the continuity of major strata groups across large areas in the British series and proposed the creation of standard geological maps.54

Leibnitz, 1680.—The great mathematician Leibnitz published his "Protogœa" in 1680. He imagined this planet to have been originally a burning luminous mass, which ever since its creation has been undergoing refrigeration. When the outer crust had cooled down sufficiently to allow the vapors to be condensed, they fell, and formed a universal ocean, covering the loftiest mountains, and investing the whole globe. The crust, as it consolidated from a state of fusion, assumed a vesicular and cavernous structure; and being rent in some places, allowed the water to rush into the subterranean hollows, whereby the level of the primeval ocean was lowered. The breaking in of these vast caverns is supposed to have given rise to the dislocated and deranged position of the strata "which Steno had described," and the same disruptions communicated 27 violent movements to the incumbent waters, whence great inundations ensued. The waters, after they had been thus agitated, deposited their sedimentary matter during intervals of quiescence, and hence the various stony and earthy strata. "We may recognize, therefore," says Leibnitz, "a double origin of primitive masses, the one by refrigeration from igneous fusion, the other by concretion from aqueous solution."55 By the repetition of similar causes (the disruption of the crust and consequent floods), alternations of new strata were produced, until at length these causes were reduced to a condition of quiescent equilibrium, and a more permanent state of things was established.56

Leibnitz, 1680.—The great mathematician Leibnitz published his "Protogœa" in 1680. He envisioned this planet as having originally been a burning, glowing mass, which has been cooling down ever since its creation. When the outer crust cooled enough for the vapors to condense, they fell, forming a universal ocean that covered the highest mountains and enveloped the entire globe. The crust, as it solidified from a molten state, took on a porous and cavernous structure; and in some places where it cracked, water rushed into the underground cavities, lowering the level of the primordial ocean. The collapse of these vast caverns is thought to have caused the misaligned and chaotic positioning of the layers "which Steno had described," and the same disruptions created violent movements in the overlying waters, leading to great floods. After these waters were agitated, they deposited their sediment during quiet periods, resulting in the various stone and soil layers. "We may recognize, therefore," says Leibnitz, "a double origin of primitive masses, one through cooling from molten rock, the other through solidification from dissolved water." By repeating similar processes (the disruption of the crust and subsequent floods), new layers were formed until these processes settled into a state of quiet balance, establishing a more stable condition.55 By the repetition of similar causes (the disruption of the crust and consequent floods), alternations of new strata were produced, until at length these causes were reduced to a condition of quiescent equilibrium, and a more permanent state of things was established.56

Hooke, 1688.—The "Posthumous Works of Robert Hooke, M. D.," well known as a great mathematician and natural philosopher, appeared in 1705, containing "A Discourse of Earthquakes," which, we are informed by his editor, was written in 1668, but revised at subsequent periods.57 Hooke frequently refers to the best Italian and English authors who wrote before his time on geological subjects; but there are no passages in his works implying that he participated in the enlarged views of Steno and Lister, or of his contemporary, Woodward, in regard to the geographical extent of certain groups of strata. His treatise, however, is the most philosophical production of that age, in regard to the causes of former changes in the organic and inorganic kingdoms of nature.

Hooke, 1688.—The "Posthumous Works of Robert Hooke, M. D.," recognized as a notable mathematician and natural philosopher, were published in 1705. This collection includes "A Discourse of Earthquakes," which, according to his editor, was originally written in 1668 but revised at various later times.57 Hooke often references leading Italian and English authors who wrote on geological topics before him; however, there are no sections in his works suggesting that he shared the broader perspectives of Steno and Lister, or his contemporary, Woodward, about the geographical distribution of certain groups of strata. Nonetheless, his treatise is the most philosophical work of that era concerning the causes of past changes in both the organic and inorganic aspects of nature.

"However trivial a thing," he says, "a rotten shell may appear to some, yet these monuments of nature are more certain tokens of antiquity than coins or medals, since the best of those may be counterfeited or made by art and design, as may also books, manuscripts, and inscriptions, as all the learned are now sufficiently satisfied has often been actually practised," &c.; "and though it must be granted that it is very difficult to read them (the records of nature) and to raise a chronology out of them, and to state the intervals of the time wherein such or such catastrophes and mutations have happened, yet it is not impossible."58

"While it may seem insignificant," he says, "a decayed shell might appear to some, these natural artifacts are more reliable signs of history than coins or medals, since the finest of those can be faked or created through design, just like books, manuscripts, and inscriptions, as all the scholars now agree has often been truly done," &c.; "and though it must be acknowledged that it's quite challenging to interpret them (the records of nature) and to establish a timeline from them, and to determine the time periods during which specific disasters and changes occurred, it's not impossible."58

Respecting the extinction of species, Hooke was aware that the fossil ammonites, nautili, and many other shells and fossil skeletons found in England, were of different species from any then known; but he doubted whether the species had become extinct, observing that the knowledge of naturalists of all the marine species, especially those inhabiting the deep sea, was very deficient. In some parts of his writings, 28 however, he leans to the opinion that species had been lost; and in speculating on this subject, he even suggests that there might be some connection between the disappearance of certain kinds of animals and plants, and the changes wrought by earthquakes in former ages. Some species, he observes, with great sagacity, are "peculiar to certain places, and not to be found elsewhere. If, then, such a place had been swallowed up, it is not improbable but that those animate beings may have been destroyed with it; and this may be true both of aerial and aquatic animals; for those animated bodies, whether vegetables or animals, which were naturally nourished or refreshed by the air, would be destroyed by the water," &c.59 Turtles, he adds, and such large ammonites as are found in Portland, seem to have been the productions of hotter countries; and it is necessary to suppose that England once lay under the sea within the torrid zone! To explain this and similar phenomena, he indulges in a variety of speculations concerning changes in the position of the axis of the earth's rotation, "a shifting of the earth's centre of gravity, analogous to the revolutions of the magnetic pole," &c. None of these conjectures, however, are proposed dogmatically, but rather in the hope of promoting fresh inquiries and experiments.

Respecting the extinction of species, Hooke recognized that the fossil ammonites, nautili, and many other shells and fossil skeletons found in England were different from any known species at the time; however, he questioned whether those species had actually gone extinct. He noted that naturalists had limited knowledge of all marine species, particularly those living in the deep sea. In some parts of his writings, 28 he leans towards the idea that some species had been lost; and while speculating on this topic, he even suggests there might be a connection between the disappearance of certain animals and plants and the changes caused by earthquakes in earlier times. He wisely points out that some species are "peculiar to certain places, and not found anywhere else." If a specific location was swallowed up, it’s not unlikely that those organisms may have been destroyed along with it; and this could apply to both aerial and aquatic animals. Those living organisms, whether plants or animals, that relied on air for their nourishment would have been obliterated by water," &c.59 He adds that turtles and large ammonites found in Portland seem to have come from warmer regions; thus, it's necessary to assume that England once lay beneath the sea within the torrid zone! To explain this and similar occurrences, he speculates about changes in the position of the earth's rotational axis, "a shift of the earth's center of gravity, similar to the movements of the magnetic pole," &c. None of these theories, however, are put forward as certainties, but rather in the hope of encouraging new inquiries and experiments.

In opposition to the prejudices of his age, we find him arguing against the idea that nature had formed fossil bodies "for no other end than to play the mimic in the mineral kingdom;"—maintaining that figured stones were "really the several bodies they represent, or the mouldings of them petrified," and not, as some have imagined, 'a lusus naturæ,' sporting herself in the needless formation of useless beings."60

In contrast to the biases of his time, we see him challenging the belief that nature created fossilized bodies "just to imitate things in the mineral world;"—arguing that the shaped stones were "actually the distinct bodies they depict, or the impressions of them turned to stone," and not, as some have thought, 'a whim of nature,' just messing around by creating pointless entities."60

It was objected to Hooke, that his doctrine of the extinction of species derogated from the wisdom and power of the omnipotent Creator; but he answered, that, as individuals die, there may be some termination to the duration of a species; and his opinions, he declared, were not repugnant to Holy Writ: for the Scriptures taught that our system was degenerating, and tending to its final dissolution; "and as, when that shall happen, all the species will be lost, why not some at one time and some at another?"61

Some people criticized Hooke, saying that his idea about the extinction of species undermined the wisdom and power of the all-powerful Creator. He responded that, just as individual organisms die, there could be an end to the existence of a species. He insisted that his views were not in conflict with the Scriptures, which teach that our system is deteriorating and headed toward its eventual collapse; “and since, when that happens, all species will be lost, why not lose some at one time and others at another?”61

But his principal object was to account for the manner in which shells 29 had been conveyed into the higher parts of "the Alps, Apennines, and Pyrenean hills, and the interior of continents in general." These and other appearances, he said, might have been brought about by earthquakes, "which have turned plains into mountains, and mountains into plains, seas into land, and land into seas, made rivers where there were none before, and swallowed up others that formerly were, &c., &c.; and which, since the creation of the world, have wrought many great changes on the superficial parts of the earth, and have been the instruments of placing shells, bones, plants, fishes, and the like, in those places where, with much astonishment, we find them."62 This doctrine, it is true, had been laid down in terms almost equally explicit by Strabo, to explain the occurrence of fossil shells in the interior of continents, and to that geographer, and other writers of antiquity, Hooke frequently refers; but the revival and development of the system was an important step in the progress of modern science.

But his main goal was to explain how shells 29 got to the higher regions of "the Alps, Apennines, and Pyrenean hills, as well as the interiors of continents in general." He suggested that these and other phenomena might have occurred due to earthquakes, "which have transformed plains into mountains and mountains into plains, seas into land and land into seas, created rivers where there were none before, and swallowed up others that used to exist, etc., etc.; and which, since the beginning of the world, have caused many significant changes to the surface of the earth, and have played a role in placing shells, bones, plants, fishes, and similar items in those locations where we find them with great surprise."62 This idea, it’s true, had been almost as clearly articulated by Strabo to explain the presence of fossil shells in the interior of continents, and Hooke often references that geographer and other ancient writers; however, the revival and expansion of this theory was an important advancement in the evolution of modern science.

Hooke enumerated all the examples known to him of subterranean disturbance, from "the sad catastrophe of Sodom and Gomorrah," down to the Chilian earthquake of 1646. The elevating of the bottom of the sea, the sinking and submersion of the land, and most of the inequalities of the earth's surface, might, he said, be accounted for by the agency of these subterranean causes. He mentions that the coast near Naples was raised during the eruption of Monte Nuovo; and that, in 1591, land rose in the island of St. Michael, during an eruption: and although it would be more difficult, he says, to prove, he does not doubt but that there had been as many earthquakes in the parts of the earth under the ocean, as in the parts of the dry land; in confirmation of which, he mentions the immeasurable depth of the sea near some volcanoes. To attest the extent of simultaneous subterranean movements, he refers to an earthquake in the West Indies, in the year 1690, where the space of earth raised, or "struck upwards," by the shock, exceeded, he affirms, the length of the Alps and Pyrenees.

Hooke listed all the examples he knew of underground disturbances, from "the tragic disaster of Sodom and Gomorrah" to the Chilian earthquake of 1646. He stated that the rising of the ocean floor, the sinking and flooding of land, and most of the unevenness of the earth's surface could be explained by these underground causes. He noted that the coast near Naples was raised during the eruption of Monte Nuovo and that, in 1591, land rose in the island of St. Michael during an eruption. Although he admitted it would be harder to prove, he believed there had been just as many earthquakes beneath the ocean as there had been on land; he supported this by mentioning the incredible depth of the sea near some volcanoes. To illustrate the scale of simultaneous underground movements, he referenced an earthquake in the West Indies in 1690, where the area of land that was lifted or "pushed up" by the shock was, he claimed, greater than the combined length of the Alps and Pyrenees.

Hooke's diluvial Theory.—As Hooke declared the favorite hypothesis of the day, "that marine fossil bodies were to be referred to Noah's flood," to be wholly untenable, he appears to have felt himself called upon to substitute a diluvial theory of his own, and thus he became involved in countless difficulties and contradictions. "During the great catastrophe," he said, "there might have been a changing of that part which was before dry land into sea by sinking, and of that which was sea into dry land by raising, and marine bodies might have been buried in sediment beneath the ocean, in the interval between the creation and the deluge."63 Then follows a disquisition on the separation of the land from the waters, mentioned in Genesis; during which operation some places of the shell of the earth were forced outwards, and others pressed downwards or inwards, &c. His diluvial hypothesis very much resembled that of Steno, and was entirely opposed to the fundamental 30 principles professed by him, that he would explain the former changes of the earth in a more natural manner than others had done. When, in despite of this declaration, he required a former "crisis of nature," and taught that earthquakes had become debilitated, and that the Alps, Andes, and other chains, had been lifted up in a few months, he was compelled to assume so rapid a rate of change, that his machinery appeared scarcely less extravagant than that of his most fanciful predecessors. For this reason, perhaps, his whole theory of earthquakes met with undeserved neglect.

Hooke's Diluvial Theory.—Hooke dismissed the popular theory of his time that "marine fossil bodies should be linked to Noah's flood" as totally implausible. In response, he felt the need to create his own diluvial theory, which led him into many challenges and contradictions. "During the great catastrophe," he stated, "the dry land could have turned into sea by sinking, while the sea could have risen to form new dry land. Marine organisms might have been buried in sediment below the ocean between the time of creation and the flood."63 He then discussed the separation of land from water as mentioned in Genesis, explaining that during this process, some areas of the Earth's crust were pushed outward while others were pushed downward or inward, etc. His diluvial theory was quite similar to Steno's and stood in direct contrast to his own core beliefs, claiming he could explain past changes to the Earth more naturally than others. However, in spite of this claim, he required a previous "crisis of nature" and suggested that earthquakes had weakened, and that mountain ranges like the Alps and Andes had risen in a matter of months. This forced him to propose such rapid changes that his explanation seemed nearly as absurd as those of his most imaginative predecessors. Perhaps this is why his entire theory on earthquakes was largely overlooked.

Ray, 1692.—One of his contemporaries, the celebrated naturalist, Ray, participated in the same desire to explain geological phenomena by reference to causes less hypothetical than those usually resorted to.64 In his essay on "Chaos and Creation," he proposed a system, agreeing in its outline, and in many of its details, with that of Hooke; but his knowledge of natural history enabled him to elucidate the subject with various original observations. Earthquakes, he suggested, might have been the second causes employed at the creation, in separating the land from the waters, and in gathering the waters together into one place. He mentions, like Hooke, the earthquake of 1646, which had violently shaken the Andes for some hundreds of leagues, and made many alterations therein. In assigning a cause for the general deluge, he preferred a change in the earth's centre of gravity to the introduction of earthquakes. Some unknown cause, he said, might have forced the subterranean waters outwards, as was, perhaps, indicated by "the breaking up of the fountains of the great deep."

Ray, 1692.—One of his contemporaries, the famous naturalist Ray, shared the same goal of explaining geological phenomena using less speculative causes than were typically used.64 In his essay on "Chaos and Creation," he proposed a system that aligned in its outline and many details with Hooke’s. However, his background in natural history allowed him to clarify the topic with various unique observations. He suggested that earthquakes could have been the secondary causes used during creation, in separating the land from the waters and gathering the waters into one location. He mentioned, like Hooke, the earthquake of 1646, which had violently shaken the Andes across several hundred leagues, causing many changes in the region. When explaining the cause of the global flood, he preferred a shift in the earth’s center of gravity over the introduction of earthquakes. He speculated that some unknown force might have pushed the underground waters outward, as perhaps suggested by "the breaking up of the fountains of the great deep."

Ray was one of the first of our writers who enlarged upon the effects of running water upon the land, and of the encroachment of the sea upon the shores. So important did he consider the agency of these causes, that he saw in them an indication of the tendency of our system to its final dissolution; and he wondered why the earth did not proceed more rapidly towards a general submersion beneath the sea, when so much matter was carried down by rivers, or undermined in the sea-cliffs. We perceive clearly from his writings, that the gradual decline of our system, and its future consummation by fire, was held to be as necessary an article of faith by the orthodox, as was the recent origin of our planet. His discourses, like those of Hooke, are highly interesting, as attesting the familiar association in the minds of philosophers, in the age of Newton, of questions in physics and divinity. Ray gave an unequivocal proof of the sincerity of his mind, by sacrificing his preferment in the church, rather than take an oath against the Covenanters, which he could not reconcile with his conscience. His reputation, moreover, in the scientific world placed him high above the temptation of courting popularity, by pandering to the physico-theological taste of his age. It is, therefore, 31 curious to meet with so many citations from the Christian fathers and prophets in his essays on physical science—to find him in one page proceeding, by the strict rules of induction, to explain the former changes of the globe, and in the next gravely entertaining the question, whether the sun and stars, and the whole heavens, shall be annihilated, together with the earth, at the era of the grand conflagration.

Ray was one of the first writers to expand on how running water affects the land and how the sea encroaches upon the shores. He considered the impact of these causes so significant that he viewed them as signs of our system's eventual collapse. He wondered why the earth didn't sink more quickly beneath the sea, given how much sediment was carried away by rivers or eroded from the sea cliffs. His writings clearly show that he believed in the gradual decline of our system and its ultimate end by fire, as firmly as the orthodox believe in the recent origin of our planet. His discussions, much like those of Hooke, are quite interesting, as they highlight how philosophers in Newton’s time often linked questions of physics with theology. Ray demonstrated his integrity by giving up his position in the church rather than taking an oath against the Covenanters, which his conscience wouldn't allow. Additionally, his standing in the scientific community elevated him above the temptation to gain popularity by catering to the physico-theological interests of his time. It’s therefore 31 intriguing to see so many references to Christian fathers and prophets in his essays on physical science—jumping from discussing the strict rules of induction to explain the earth's past changes, to seriously pondering whether the sun, stars, and the entire universe will be destroyed along with the earth at the time of the great fire.

Woodward, 1695.—Among the contemporaries of Hooke and Ray, Woodward, a professor of medicine, had acquired the most extensive information respecting the geological structure of the crust of the earth. He had examined many parts of the British strata with minute attention; and his systematic collection of specimens, bequeathed to the University of Cambridge, and still preserved there as arranged by him, shows how far he had advanced in ascertaining the order of superposition. From the great number of facts collected by him, we might have expected his theoretical views to be more sound and enlarged than those of his contemporaries; but in his anxiety to accommodate all observed phenomena to the scriptural account of the Creation and Deluge, he arrived at most erroneous results. He conceived "the whole terrestrial globe to have been taken to pieces and dissolved at the flood, and the strata to have settled down from this promiscuous mass as any earthy sediment from a fluid."65 In corroboration of these views he insisted upon the fact, that "marine bodies are lodged in the strata according to the order of their gravity, the heavier shells in stone, the lighter in chalk, and so of the rest."66 Ray immediately exposed the unfounded nature of this assertion, remarking truly that fossil bodies "are often mingled, heavy with light, in the same stratum;" and he even went so far as to say, that Woodward "must have invented the phenomena for the sake of confirming his bold and strange hypothesis"67—a strong expression from the pen of a contemporary.

Woodward, 1695.—Among the peers of Hooke and Ray, Woodward, a professor of medicine, gathered the most extensive knowledge about the geological structure of the earth's crust. He meticulously examined many parts of the British geological strata, and his systematic collection of specimens, left to the University of Cambridge and still preserved there as he arranged them, illustrates how far he advanced in understanding the order of superposition. Given the vast number of facts he collected, we might have expected his theoretical insights to be more accurate and broader than those of his contemporaries; however, in his eagerness to align all observed phenomena with the biblical accounts of Creation and the Flood, he reached highly incorrect conclusions. He believed "the entire terrestrial globe was taken apart and dissolved during the flood, and the strata settled from this mixed mass like any sediment from a fluid."65 To support these views, he insisted on the fact that "marine bodies are found in the strata according to their weight, with heavier shells in stone, lighter in chalk, and so forth."66 Ray quickly pointed out the unfounded nature of this claim, accurately stating that fossil bodies "are often mixed, heavy with light, within the same stratum;" and he even went so far as to suggest that Woodward "must have fabricated the phenomena to validate his bold and strange hypothesis"67—a strong statement from a contemporary.

Burnet, 1690.—At the same time Burnet published his "Theory of the Earth."68 The title is most characteristic of the age,—"The Sacred Theory of the Earth; containing an Account of the Original of the Earth, and of all the general Changes which it hath already undergone, or is to undergo, till the Consummation of all Things." Even Milton had scarcely ventured in his poem to indulge his imagination so freely in painting scenes of the Creation and Deluge, Paradise and Chaos. He explained why the primeval earth enjoyed a perpetual spring before the flood! showed how the crust of the globe was fissured by "the sun's rays," so that it burst, and thus the diluvial waters were let loose from a supposed central abyss. Not satisfied with these themes, he derived from the books of the inspired writers, and even from heathen authorities, prophetic views of the future revolutions of the globe, gave a most terrific description of the general conflagration, and proved that 32 a new heaven and a new earth will rise out of a second chaos—after which will follow the blessed millennium.

Burnet, 1690.—At the same time, Burnet published his "Theory of the Earth."68 The title reflects the era well,—"The Sacred Theory of the Earth; containing an Account of the Original of the Earth, and of all the general Changes which it has already undergone, or is to undergo, until the Consummation of all Things." Even Milton hardly dared in his poem to unleash his imagination so freely in describing scenes of Creation and the Flood, Paradise and Chaos. He explained why the original earth experienced a constant spring before the flood! He showed how the crust of the globe was cracked by "the sun's rays," causing it to burst, releasing the floodwaters from a supposed central abyss. Not content with these topics, he drew from the writings of inspired authors, and even from pagan sources, prophetic insights about future changes to the globe, gave a chilling description of the great fire, and proved that a new heaven and a new earth will emerge from a second chaos—after which a blessed millennium will follow.

The reader should be informed, that, according to the opinion of many respectable writers of that age, there was good scriptural ground for presuming that the garden bestowed upon our first parents was not on the earth itself, but above the clouds, in the middle region between our planet and the moon. Burnet approaches with becoming gravity the discussion of so important a topic. He was willing to concede that the geographical position of Paradise was not in Mesopotamia, yet he maintained that it was upon the earth, and in the southern hemisphere, near the equinoctial line. Butler selected this conceit as a fair mark for his satire, when, amongst the numerous accomplishments of Hudibras, he says,—

The reader should know that many respected writers from that time believed there was solid scriptural basis for thinking that the garden given to our first parents wasn’t on Earth but rather above the clouds, in the area between our planet and the moon. Burnet approaches this significant topic with the seriousness it deserves. He was willing to agree that Paradise was not located in Mesopotamia, yet he argued that it was on Earth, in the southern hemisphere, close to the equatorial line. Butler chose this idea as a suitable target for his satire when, among the many traits of Hudibras, he says,—

"He knew the seat of Paradise, Could tell in what degree it lies; And, as he was disposed, could prove it Below the moon, or else above it."

"He knew where Paradise was, Could you explain how far it is? And, depending on his mood, could show it. "Below the moon, or perhaps beyond it."

Yet the same monarch, who is said never to have slept without Butler's poem under his pillow, was so great an admirer and patron of Burnet's book, that he ordered it to be translated from the Latin into English. The style of the "Sacred Theory" was eloquent, and the book displayed powers of invention of no ordinary stamp. It was, in fact, a fine historical romance, as Buffon afterwards declared; but it was treated as a work of profound science in the time of its author, and was panegyrized by Addison in a Latin ode, while Steele praised it in the "Spectator."

Yet the same king, who supposedly never went to sleep without Butler's poem under his pillow, was such a big fan and supporter of Burnet's book that he had it translated from Latin into English. The style of the "Sacred Theory" was eloquent, and the book showcased a remarkable level of creativity. It was essentially a great historical romance, as Buffon later pointed out; however, it was regarded as a serious scientific work during its author's time, and was celebrated by Addison in a Latin ode, while Steele praised it in the "Spectator."

Whiston, 1696.—Another production of the same school, and equally characteristic of the time, was that of Whiston, entitled, "A New Theory of the Earth; wherein the Creation of the world in Six Days, the Universal Deluge, and the General Conflagration, as laid down in the Holy Scriptures, are shown to be perfectly agreeable to Reason and Philosophy." He was at first a follower of Burnet; but his faith in the infallibility of that writer was shaken by the declared opinion of Newton, that there was every presumption in astronomy against any former change in the inclination of the earth's axis. This was a leading dogma in Burnet's system, though not original, for it was borrowed from an Italian, Alessandro degli Alessandri, who had suggested it in the beginning of the fifteenth century, to account for the former occupation of the present continents by the sea. La Place has since strengthened the arguments of Newton, against the probability of any former revolution of this kind.

Whiston, 1696.—Another work from this same school, which is just as characteristic of the period, was Whiston's titled, "A New Theory of the Earth; where the Creation of the world in Six Days, the Universal Flood, and the General Fire, as described in the Holy Scriptures, are shown to be completely compatible with Reason and Philosophy." Initially, he followed Burnet; however, his belief in that writer's infallibility was undermined by Newton's assertion that there was significant evidence in astronomy against any past change in the tilt of the earth's axis. This was a central tenet in Burnet's theory, though it was not original, as it was borrowed from an Italian, Alessandro degli Alessandri, who suggested it in the early fifteenth century to explain the previous submersion of the current continents under the sea. La Place has since reinforced Newton's arguments against the likelihood of any prior revolution of this kind.

The remarkable comet of 1680 was fresh in the memory of every one when Whiston first began his cosmological studies; and the principal novelty of his speculations consisted in attributing the deluge to the near approach to the earth of one of these erratic bodies. Having ascribed an increase of the waters to this source, he adopted Woodward's 33 theory, supposing all stratified deposits to have resulted from the "chaotic sediment of the flood." Whiston was one of the first who ventured to propose that the text of Genesis should be interpreted differently from its ordinary acceptation, so that the doctrine of the earth having existed long previous to the creation of man might no longer be regarded as unorthodox. He had the art to throw an air of plausibility over the most improbable parts of his theory, and seemed to be proceeding in the most sober manner, and, by the aid of mathematical demonstration, to the establishment of his various propositions. Locke pronounced a panegyric on his theory, commending him for having explained so many wonderful and before inexplicable things. His book, as well as Burnet's, was attacked and refuted by Keill.69 Like all who introduced purely hypothetical causes to account for natural phenomena, Whiston retarded the progress of truth, diverting men from the investigation of the laws of sublunary nature, and inducing them to waste time in speculations on the power of comets to drag the waters of the ocean over the land—on the condensation of the vapors of their tails into water, and other matters equally edifying.

The famous comet of 1680 was still fresh in everyone's mind when Whiston started his studies on the universe. The main innovation in his ideas was claiming that the flood was caused by one of these wandering bodies getting close to the earth. He attributed the rise in water levels to this event and adopted Woodward's theory, believing that all layered deposits were formed from the "chaotic sediment of the flood." Whiston was one of the first to suggest that the text of Genesis should be interpreted differently than usual, allowing for the idea that the earth existed long before humans were created to no longer be seen as unorthodox. He had a talent for making the most unlikely parts of his theory seem plausible and appeared to be progressing in a sober manner, supported by mathematical proof, to confirm his various claims. Locke praised his theory, applauding him for explaining many remarkable and previously inexplicable phenomena. His book, along with Burnet's, was criticized and refuted by Keill.69 Like many who introduced purely hypothetical causes to explain natural events, Whiston hindered the advancement of knowledge, steering people away from investigating the laws of nature, and leading them to waste time speculating about whether comets could pull ocean waters over land, or whether the vapor from their tails could condense into water, along with other equally trivial matters.

Hutchinson, 1724.—John Hutchinson, who had been employed by Woodward in making his collection of fossils, published afterwards, in 1724, the first part of his "Moses's Principia," wherein he ridiculed Woodward's hypothesis. He and his numerous followers were accustomed to declaim loudly against human learning; and they maintained that the Hebrew Scriptures, when rightly translated, comprised a perfect system of natural philosophy, for which reason they objected to the Newtonian theory of gravitation.

Hutchinson, 1724.—John Hutchinson, who had worked with Woodward on his fossil collection, later published the first part of his "Moses's Principia" in 1724, where he mocked Woodward's ideas. He and his many followers often spoke out against human knowledge, arguing that the Hebrew Scriptures, when properly translated, included a complete system of natural philosophy. This was why they opposed the Newtonian theory of gravitation.

Celsius.—Andrea Celsius, the Swedish astronomer, published about this time his remarks on the gradual diminution and sinking of the waters in the Baltic, to which I shall have occasion to advert more particularly in the sequel (ch. 29).

Celsius.—Andrea Celsius, the Swedish astronomer, published his observations around this time on the gradual decrease and lowering of the waters in the Baltic, which I will discuss in more detail later (ch. 29).

Scheuchzer, 1708.—In Germany, in the mean time, Scheuchzer published his "Complaint and Vindication of the Fishes" (1708), "Piscium Querelæ et Vindiciæ," a work of zoological merit, in which he gave some good plates and descriptions of fossil fish. Among other conclusions he labored to prove that the earth had been remodelled at the deluge. Pluche, also, in 1732, wrote to the same effect; while Holbach, in 1753, after considering the various attempts to refer all the ancient formations to the flood of Noah, exposed the inadequacy of this cause.

Scheuchzer, 1708.—Meanwhile, in Germany, Scheuchzer published his "Complaint and Vindication of the Fishes" (1708), "Piscium Querelæ et Vindiciæ," a work of zoological importance, which included some impressive illustrations and descriptions of fossil fish. Among other points, he tried to prove that the Earth had been reshaped during the flood. Pluche, in 1732, wrote in support of this idea; while Holbach, in 1753, after reviewing various attempts to link all ancient formations to Noah's flood, highlighted the shortcomings of this explanation.

Italian Geologists—Vallisneri.—I return with pleasure to the geologists of Italy, who preceded, as has been already shown, the naturalists of other countries in their investigations into the ancient history of the earth, and who still maintained a decided pre-eminence. They refuted and ridiculed the physico-theological systems of Burnet, Whiston, 34 and Woodward;70 while Vallisneri,71 in his comments on the Woodwardian theory, remarked how much the interests of religion, as well as those of sound philosophy, had suffered by perpetually mixing up the sacred writings with questions in physical science. The works of this author were rich in original observations. He attempted the first general sketch of the marine deposits of Italy, their geographical extent, and most characteristic organic remains. In his treatise "On the Origin of Springs," he explained their dependence on the order, and often on the dislocations, of the strata, and reasoned philosophically against the opinions of those who regarded the disordered state of the earth's crust as exhibiting signs of the wrath of God for the sins of man. He found himself under the necessity of contending, in his preliminary chapter, against St. Jerome, and four other principal interpreters of Scripture, besides several professors of divinity, "that springs did not flow by subterranean siphons and cavities from the sea upwards, losing their saltness in the passage," for this theory had been made to rest on the infallible testimony of Holy Writ.

Italian Geologists—Vallisneri.—I happily return to the geologists of Italy, who, as previously shown, were ahead of naturalists in other countries in exploring the ancient history of the earth and who still held a clear advantage. They challenged and mocked the physico-theological ideas of Burnet, Whiston, 34 and Woodward; 70 while Vallisneri, 71 in his comments on the Woodwardian theory, pointed out how much the interests of religion, as well as sound philosophy, had suffered by constantly mixing the sacred texts with issues in physical science. The works of this author were full of original observations. He made the first general overview of the marine deposits of Italy, their geographical extent, and the most distinctive organic remains. In his treatise "On the Origin of Springs," he clarified how they depended on the arrangement, and often on the dislocations, of the layers, and philosophically argued against those who believed that the chaotic state of the earth's crust was a sign of God's anger over human sins. He felt it necessary to argue, in his preliminary chapter, against St. Jerome and four other major scripture interpreters, along with various divinity professors, "that springs did not flow by underground siphons and cavities from the sea upward, losing their saltiness in the process," as this theory had been based on the unquestionable authority of Holy Scripture.

Although reluctant to generalize on the rich materials accumulated in his travels, Vallisneri had been so much struck with the remarkable continuity of the more recent marine strata, from one end of Italy to the other, that he came to the conclusion that the ocean formerly extended over the whole earth, and after abiding there for a long time, had gradually subsided. This opinion, however untenable, was a great step beyond Woodward's diluvian hypothesis, against which Vallisneri, and after him all the Tuscan geologists, uniformly contended, while it was warmly supported by the members of the Institute of Bologna.72

Although hesitant to generalize from the extensive materials gathered during his travels, Vallisneri was so impressed by the consistent marine layers found throughout Italy that he concluded the ocean used to cover the entire earth and, after being there for a long time, eventually receded. This view, though flawed, represented a significant advancement beyond Woodward's flood theory, which Vallisneri, along with other Tuscan geologists, consistently opposed, while it was strongly backed by members of the Institute of Bologna.72

Among others of that day, Spada, a priest of Grezzana, in 1737, wrote to prove that the petrified marine bodies near Verona were not diluvian.73 Mattani drew a similar inference from the shells of Volterra and other places; while Costantini, on the other hand, whose observations on the valley of the Brenta and other districts were not without value, undertook to vindicate the truth of the deluge, as also to prove that Italy had been peopled by the descendants of Japhet.74

Among others from that time, Spada, a priest from Grezzana, wrote in 1737 to show that the petrified marine creatures near Verona were not from the flood.73 Mattani made a similar conclusion from the shells found in Volterra and other locations; meanwhile, Costantini, whose observations on the Brenta Valley and other areas were quite valuable, sought to defend the truth of the flood and also to prove that Italy had been populated by the descendants of Japhet.74

Moro, 1740.—Lazzaro Moro, in his work (published in 1740) "On the Marine Bodies which are found in the Mountains,"75 attempted to apply the theory of earthquakes, as expounded by Strabo, Pliny, and other ancient authors, with whom he was familiar, to the geological phenomena described by Vallisneri.76 His attention was awakened to 35 the elevating power of subterranean forces by a remarkable phenomenon which happened in his own time, and which had also been noticed by Vallisneri in his letters. A new island rose in 1707 from deep water in the Gulf of Santorin, in the Mediterranean, during continued shocks of an earthquake, and, increasing rapidly in size, grew in less than a month to be half a mile in circumference, and about twenty-five feet above high-water mark. It was soon afterwards covered by volcanic ejections, but, when first examined, it was found to be a white rock, bearing on its surface living oysters and crustacea. In order to ridicule the various theories then in vogue, Moro ingeniously supposes the arrival on this new island of a party of naturalists ignorant of its recent origin. One immediately points to the marine shells, as proofs of the universal deluge; another argues that they demonstrate the former residence of the sea upon the mountains; a third dismisses them as mere sports of nature; while a fourth affirms that they were born and nourished within the rock in ancient caverns, into which salt water had been raised in the shape of vapor by the action of subterranean heat.

Moro, 1740.—Lazzaro Moro, in his work (published in 1740) "On the Marine Bodies Found in the Mountains,"75 tried to apply the earthquake theory explained by Strabo, Pliny, and other ancient writers, whom he knew well, to the geological events described by Vallisneri.76 His interest was sparked by an extraordinary event that occurred in his lifetime, which Vallisneri had also mentioned in his letters. In 1707, during ongoing earthquake tremors, a new island emerged from deep waters in the Gulf of Santorin in the Mediterranean. It quickly expanded to half a mile in circumference and about twenty-five feet above high tide level in less than a month. Soon after, it was covered by volcanic debris, but when it was first studied, it was found to be a white rock, with living oysters and crustaceans on its surface. To mock the various theories popular at the time, Moro cleverly imagines a group of naturalists arriving on this new island, unaware of its recent formation. One points to the marine shells as evidence of a global flood; another claims they prove the sea once covered the mountains; a third dismisses them as mere sports of nature; while a fourth insists that they were formed and nurtured within the rock in ancient caves where saltwater had been brought up as vapor by underground heat.

Moro pointed with great judgment to the faults and dislocations of the strata described by Vallisneri, in the Alps and other chains, in confirmation of his doctrine, that the continents had been heaved up by subterranean movements. He objected, on solid grounds, to the hypothesis of Burnet and of Woodward; yet he ventured so far to disregard the protest of Vallisneri, as to undertake the adaptation of every part of his own system to the Mosaic account of the creation. On the third day, he said, the globe was everywhere covered to the same depth by fresh water; and when it pleased the Supreme Being that the dry land should appear, volcanic explosions broke up the smooth and regular surface of the earth composed of primary rocks. These rose in mountain masses above the waves, and allowed melted metals and salts to ascend through fissures. The sea gradually acquired its saltness from volcanic exhalations, and, while it became more circumscribed in area, increased in depth. Sand and ashes ejected by volcanoes were regularly disposed along the bottom of the ocean, and formed the secondary strata, which in their turn were lifted up by earthquakes. We need not follow this author in tracing the progress of the creation of vegetables and animals on the other days of creation; but, upon the whole, it may be remarked, that few of the old cosmological theories had been conceived with so little violation of known analogies.

Moro carefully pointed out the flaws and disruptions in the layers described by Vallisneri in the Alps and other mountain ranges, supporting his belief that continents were raised by underground movements. He argued against the theories of Burnet and Woodward on solid grounds, yet he still chose to align every aspect of his own theory with the Biblical account of creation. He stated that on the third day, the entire globe was covered by fresh water to the same depth, and when it was time for dry land to appear, volcanic eruptions broke apart the smooth and even surface of the earth made up of primary rocks. These rocks rose in mountain formations above the water, allowing melted metals and salts to rise through cracks. The sea slowly became salty due to volcanic emissions, and as it grew smaller in area, it became deeper. Sand and ash from volcanic eruptions settled on the ocean floor, forming secondary layers, which were later raised by earthquakes. We don’t need to delve into this author's account of the creation of plants and animals on the other days; however, it’s worth noting that few of the old cosmological theories were developed with so little deviation from known principles.

Generelli's illustrations of Moro, 1749.—The style of Moro was extremely prolix, and, like Hutton, who, at a later period, advanced many of the same views, he stood in need of an illustrator. The Scotch geologist was hardly more fortunate in the advocacy of Playfair, than was Moro in numbering amongst his admirers Cirillo Generelli, who, nine 36 years afterwards, delivered at a sitting of Academicians at Cremona a spirited exposition of his theory. This learned Carmelitan friar does not pretend to have been an original observer, but he had studied sufficiently to enable him to confirm the opinions of Moro by arguments from other writers; and his selection of the doctrines then best established is so judicious, that a brief abstract of them cannot fail to be acceptable, as illustrating the state of geology in Europe, and in Italy in particular, before the middle of the last century.

Generelli's illustrations of Moro, 1749.—Moro's style was very wordy, and like Hutton, who later expressed similar ideas, he needed someone to illustrate his work. The Scottish geologist was hardly more successful in having Playfair advocate for him than Moro was in having Cirillo Generelli as one of his supporters, who, nine 36 years later, gave an enthusiastic presentation of his theory at a meeting of Academicians in Cremona. This learned Carmelite friar doesn't claim to be an original observer, but he studied enough to back up Moro's views with arguments from other writers. His choice of the most established doctrines at the time is so wise that a brief summary of them will surely be useful in illustrating the state of geology in Europe, and particularly in Italy, before the mid-18th century.

The bowels of the earth, says he, have carefully preserved the memorials of past events, and this truth the marine productions so frequent in the hills attest. From the reflections of Lazzaro Moro, we may assure ourselves that these are the effects of earthquakes in past times, which have changed vast spaces of sea into terra firma, and inhabited lands into seas. In this, more than in any other department of physics, are observations and experiments indispensable, and we must diligently consider facts. The land is known, wherever we make excavations, to be composed of different strata or soils placed one above the other, some of sand, some of rock, some of chalk, others of marl, coal, pummice, gypsum, lime, and the rest. These ingredients are sometimes pure, and sometimes confusedly intermixed. Within are often imprisoned different marine fishes, like dried mummies, and more frequently shells, crustacea, corals, plants, &c., not only in Italy, but in France, Germany, England, Africa, Asia, and America;—sometimes in the lowest, sometimes in the loftiest beds of the earth, some upon the mountains, some in deep mines, others near the sea, and others hundreds of miles distant from it. Woodward conjectured that these marine bodies might be found everywhere; but there are rocks in which none of them occur, as is sufficiently attested by Vallisneri and Marsilli. The remains of fossil animals consist chiefly of their more solid parts, and the most rocky strata must have been soft when such exuviæ were inclosed in them. Vegetable productions are found in different states of maturity, indicating that they were imbedded in different seasons. Elephants, elks, and other terrestrial quadrupeds, have been found in England and elsewhere, in superficial strata, never covered by the sea. Alternations are rare, yet not without example, of marine strata, with those which contain marshy and terrestrial productions. Marine animals are arranged in the subterraneous beds with admirable order, in distinct groups, oysters here, dentalia or corals there, &c., as now, according to Marsilli,77 on the shores of the Adriatic. We must abandon the doctrine, once so popular, which denies that organized fossils were derived from living beings, and we cannot account for their present position by the ancient theory of Strabo, nor by that of Leibnitz, nor by the universal deluge, as explained by Woodward and others; "nor is it reasonable to call the Deity capriciously upon the stage, and to make him work miracles for the sake of confirming our preconceived 37 hypothesis."—"I hold in utter abomination, most learned Academicians! those systems which are built with their foundations in the air, and cannot be propped up without a miracle; and I undertake, with the assistance of Moro, to explain to you how these marine animals were transported into the mountains by natural causes."78

The depths of the earth, he says, have carefully preserved the records of past events, and the numerous marine fossils found in the hills confirm this. From Lazzaro Moro's reflections, we can conclude that these are the results of earthquakes in earlier times, which transformed large areas of ocean into solid land and dry regions into seas. In this area of physics more than any other, observations and experiments are crucial, and we must carefully examine the evidence. The land is known, no matter where we dig, to consist of various layers of soil stacked on top of each other—some are sandy, some rocky, some chalky, others marl, coal, pumice, gypsum, lime, and more. These materials can be found either pure or mixed together. Often, we find different marine creatures trapped inside, like dried mummies, and more frequently shells, crustaceans, corals, plants, etc., not only in Italy but also in France, Germany, England, Africa, Asia, and America; sometimes in the deepest layers, sometimes in the highest, some on mountains, others in deep mines, and others hundreds of miles from the sea. Woodward speculated that these marine bodies could be found everywhere; however, there are rocks where none are present, as Vallisneri and Marsilli have sufficiently demonstrated. The remains of fossil animals mainly consist of their more durable parts, and the most compact layers must have been soft when these remains were enclosed in them. Plant materials are found in various stages of decay, suggesting they were buried during different seasons. Elephants, elk, and other land animals have been discovered in England and other places in surface layers never covered by the sea. Although rare, there are instances of marine layers alternating with those containing marshy and terrestrial fossils. Marine creatures are organized in underground layers with impressive order, in distinct groups—oysters here, dentalia or corals there, etc., similar to what is seen today, according to Marsilli, on the shores of the Adriatic. We must reject the previously popular belief that organized fossils came from living organisms, and we can’t explain their current location using Strabo's ancient theory, Leibnitz's ideas, or the universal flood concept as put forth by Woodward and others; "nor is it reasonable to invoke the Deity randomly to perform miracles just to support our preconceived notions."—"I have nothing but disdain, esteemed Academicians, for those theories that are built on shaky foundations and require miracles to stand; and I am committed, with Moro's help, to explain how these marine creatures were carried into the mountains by natural events."

A brief abstract then follows of Moro's theory, by which, says Generelli, we may explain all the phenomena, as Vallisneri so ardently desired, "without violence, without fictions, without hypothesis, without miracles."79 The Carmelitan then proceeds to struggle against an obvious objection to Moro's system, considered as a method of explaining the revolutions of the earth, naturally. If earthquakes have been the agents of such mighty changes, how does it happen that their effects since the times of history have been so inconsiderable? This same difficulty had, as we have seen, presented itself to Hooke, half a century before, and forced him to resort to a former "crisis of nature:" but Generelli defended his position by showing how numerous were the accounts of eruptions and earthquakes, of new islands, and of elevations and subsidences of land, and yet how much greater a number of like events must have been unattested and unrecorded during the last six thousand years. He also appealed to Vallisneri as an authority to prove that the mineral masses containing shells, bore, upon the whole, but a small proportion to those rocks which were destitute of organic remains; and the latter, says the learned monk, might have been created as they now exist, in the beginning.

A brief summary of Moro's theory follows, which, according to Generelli, allows us to explain all phenomena, just as Vallisneri so passionately wanted, "without violence, without fictions, without hypothesis, without miracles."79 The Carmelitan then addresses a clear objection to Moro's approach, viewed as a way of explaining the Earth's changes in a natural manner. If earthquakes have caused such significant changes, why have their effects been so minimal since recorded history? This issue had already arisen for Hooke, half a century earlier, prompting him to refer to a past "crisis of nature": but Generelli defended his stance by demonstrating the numerous accounts of eruptions and earthquakes, of new islands, and of land rising and sinking, while arguing that many more such events must have gone unrecorded over the past six thousand years. He also referenced Vallisneri to support his point that the mineral masses with shells were, overall, a small fraction of the rocks lacking organic remains; and the latter, the learned monk suggests, may have been created as they are now found, in the beginning.

Generelli then describes the continual waste of mountains and continents, by the action of rivers and torrents, and concludes with these eloquent and original observations:—"Is it possible that this waste should have continued for six thousand, and perhaps a greater number of years, and that the mountains should remain so great, unless their ruins have been repaired? Is it credible that the Author of Nature should have founded the world upon such laws, as that the dry land should forever be growing smaller, and at last become wholly submerged beneath the waters? Is it credible that, amid so many created things, the mountains alone should daily diminish in number and bulk, without there being any repair of their losses? This would be contrary to that order of Providence which is seen to reign in all other things in the universe. Wherefore I deem it just to conclude, that the same cause which, in the beginning of time, raised mountains from the abyss, has down to the present day continued to produce others, in order to restore from time to time the losses of all such as sink down in different places, or are rent asunder, or in other way suffer disintegration. If this be admitted, we can easily understand why there should now be 38 found upon many mountains so great a number of crustacea and other marine animals."

Generelli then describes the ongoing erosion of mountains and continents by rivers and torrents, concluding with these powerful and original thoughts:—"Is it possible that this erosion has gone on for six thousand, and perhaps even more years, and yet the mountains remain so tall unless their remnants have been restored? Is it believable that the Creator of Nature established the world on such principles, where dry land keeps shrinking and eventually becomes completely submerged under water? Is it believable that, among so many created things, only the mountains should constantly decrease in number and size without any recovery from their losses? This would contradict the order of Providence that we see governing everything else in the universe. Therefore, I think it’s reasonable to conclude that the same force that raised mountains from the depths at the beginning of time has continued to create new ones to replenish the losses of those that sink in various locations, break apart, or otherwise erode. If we accept this, it becomes clear why we now find 38 so many crustaceans and other marine animals on many mountains."

In the above extract, I have not merely enumerated the opinions and facts which are confirmed by recent observation, suppressing all that has since proved to be erroneous, but have given a faithful abridgment of the entire treatise, with the omission only of Moro's hypothesis, which Generelli adopted, with all its faults and excellences. The reader will therefore remark, that although this admirable essay embraces so large a portion of the principal objects of geological research, it makes no allusion to the extinction of certain classes of animals; and it is evident that no opinions on this head had, at that time, gained a firm footing in Italy. That Lister and other English naturalists should long before have declared in favor of the loss of species, while Scilla and most of his countrymen hesitated, was perhaps natural, since the Italian museums were filled with fossil shells belonging to species of which a great portion did actually exist in the Mediterranean; whereas the English collectors could obtain no recent species from such of their own strata as were then explored.

In the extract above, I haven’t just listed the opinions and facts that recent observations have confirmed while omitting what has since been proven wrong. Instead, I’ve provided a concise summary of the entire treatise, only leaving out Moro's hypothesis that Generelli adopted, with all its flaws and strengths. Therefore, the reader will notice that while this excellent essay covers many key aspects of geological research, it doesn’t mention the extinction of certain animal classes. It’s clear that no solid opinions on this matter had gained traction in Italy at that time. It’s perhaps understandable that Lister and other English naturalists declared long ago in favor of species loss, while Scilla and most of his compatriots hesitated. This difference likely arose because Italian museums were filled with fossil shells from species that largely still existed in the Mediterranean, while English collectors had no recent specimens from the strata they had explored.

The weakest point in Moro's system consisted in deriving all the stratified rocks from volcanic ejections; an absurdity which his opponents took care to expose, especially Vito Amici.80 Moro seems to have been misled by his anxious desire to represent the formation of secondary rocks as having occupied an extremely short period, while at the same time he wished to employ known agents in nature. To imagine torrents, rivers, currents, partial floods, and all the operations of moving water, to have gone on exerting an energy many thousand times greater than at present, would have appeared preposterous and incredible, and would have required a hundred violent hypotheses; but we are so unacquainted with the true sources of subterranean disturbances, that their former violence may in theory be multiplied indefinitely, without its being possible to prove the same manifest contradiction or absurdity in the conjecture. For this reason, perhaps, Moro preferred to derive the materials of the strata from volcanic ejections, rather than from transportation by running water.

The weakest point in Moro's system was claiming that all the stratified rocks came from volcanic eruptions; a ridiculous idea that his opponents, particularly Vito Amici, made sure to highlight.80 Moro seemed to be misled by his intense desire to suggest that the formation of secondary rocks happened in a very short time, while also wanting to use known natural processes. The idea that torrents, rivers, currents, and partial floods exerted an energy thousands of times greater than they do now would have seemed absurd and unbelievable, requiring countless extreme assumptions. However, since we know so little about the true causes of underground disturbances, it's theoretically possible to suggest that their past energy could be infinitely greater without proving any obvious contradiction or absurdity in that claim. For this reason, Moro may have preferred to say that the materials for the strata came from volcanic eruptions rather than from sediment carried by flowing water.

Marsilli.—Marsilli, whose work is alluded to by Generelli, had been prompted to institute inquiries into the bed of the Adriatic, by discovering, in the territory of Parma (what Spada had observed near Verona, and Schiavo in Sicily), that fossil shells were not scattered through the rocks at random, but disposed in regular order, according to certain genera and species.

Marsilli.—Marsilli, mentioned by Generelli, was motivated to investigate the seabed of the Adriatic after finding, in the Parma region (what Spada noticed near Verona, and Schiavo in Sicily), that fossil shells were not randomly distributed within the rocks but arranged in a systematic manner, according to specific genera and species.

Vitaliano Donati, 1750.—But with a view of throwing further light upon these questions, Donati, in 1750, undertook a more extensive investigation of the Adriatic, and discovered, by numerous soundings, that deposits of sand, marl, and tufaceous incrustations, most strictly analogous to those of the Subapennine hills, were in the act of accumulating there. 39 He ascertained that there were no shells in some of the submarine tracts, while in other places they lived together in families, particularly the genera Arca, Pecten, Venus, Murex, and some others. He also states that in divers localities he found a mass composed of corals, shells, and crustaceous bodies of different species, confusedly blended with earth, sand, and gravel. At the depth of a foot or more, the organic substances were entirely petrified and reduced to marble; at less than a foot from the surface, they approached nearer to their natural state; while at the surface they were alive, or, if dead, in a good state of preservation.

Vitaliano Donati, 1750.—To shed more light on these questions, Donati, in 1750, carried out a more thorough investigation of the Adriatic and found, through numerous soundings, that deposits of sand, marl, and tufaceous crust were accumulating there, closely similar to those of the Subapennine hills. 39 He discovered that there were no shells in some underwater areas, while in other places, they existed in families, particularly the genera Arca, Pecten, Venus, Murex, and a few others. He also noted that in various locations he found a mass made up of corals, shells, and crustaceous bodies of different species, mixed together with earth, sand, and gravel. At depths of a foot or more, the organic materials were completely fossilized and turned to marble; at less than a foot from the surface, they were closer to their natural state; and at the surface, they were alive, or if dead, well-preserved.

Baldassari.—A contemporary naturalist, Baldassari, had shown that the organic remains in the tertiary marls of the Siennese territory were grouped in families, in a manner precisely similar to that above alluded to by Donati.

Baldassari.—A modern naturalist, Baldassari, demonstrated that the organic remains in the tertiary marls of the Siennese area were categorized into families, similar to what Donati mentioned earlier.

Buffon, 1749.—Buffon first made known his theoretical views concerning the former changes of the earth, in his Natural History, published in 1749. He adopted the theory of an original volcanic nucleus, together with the universal ocean of Leibnitz. By this aqueous envelope the highest mountains were once covered. Marine currents then acted violently, and formed horizontal strata, by washing away solid matter in some parts, and depositing it in others; they also excavated deep submarine valleys. The level of the ocean was then depressed by the entrance of a part of its waters into subterranean caverns, and thus some land was left dry. Buffon seems not to have profited, like Leibnitz and Moro, by the observations of Steno, or he could not have imagined that the strata were generally horizontal, and that those which contain organic remains had never been disturbed since the era of their formation. He was conscious of the great power annually exerted by rivers and marine currents in transporting earthy materials to lower levels, and he even contemplated the period when they would destroy all the present continents. Although in geology he was not an original observer, his genius enabled him to render his hypothesis attractive; and by the eloquence of his style, and the boldness of his speculations, he awakened curiosity, and provoked a spirit of inquiry amongst his countrymen.

Buffon, 1749.—Buffon first shared his theoretical views about the past changes of the earth in his Natural History, published in 1749. He supported the idea of an original volcanic core, along with Leibnitz's concept of a universal ocean. This watery layer once covered the tallest mountains. Strong marine currents then created horizontal layers by eroding solid material in some areas and depositing it in others; they also carved deep underwater valleys. The ocean level later dropped as some of its water entered underground caves, which left some land exposed. Buffon didn't seem to have taken advantage of Steno's observations, like Leibnitz and Moro did, or he wouldn't have believed that the layers were mostly horizontal and that those containing organic remains had never been disturbed since they were formed. He recognized the significant power that rivers and marine currents exert each year in moving sediments to lower areas, and he even imagined a time when they would erode the current continents away. Although he wasn't an original observer in geology, his brilliance made his hypothesis engaging; through his eloquent writing and daring ideas, he sparked curiosity and inspired a quest for knowledge among his fellow countrymen.

Soon after the publication of his "Natural History," in which was included his "Theory of the Earth," he received an official letter (dated January, 1751) from the Sorbonne, or Faculty of Theology in Paris, informing him that fourteen propositions in his works "were reprehensible, and contrary to the creed of the church." The first of these obnoxious passages, and the only one relating to geology, was as follows:—"The waters of the sea have produced the mountains and valleys of the land—the waters of the heavens, reducing all to a level, will at last deliver the whole land over to the sea, and the sea successively prevailing over the land, will leave dry new continents like those which we inhabit." Buffon was invited by the College, in very courteous terms, to send in an explanation, or rather a recantation of his unorthodox opinions. 40 To this he submitted; and a general assembly of the Faculty having approved of his "Declaration," he was required to publish it in his next work. The document begins with these words:—"I declare that I had no intention to contradict the text of Scripture; that I believe most firmly all therein related about the creation, both as to order of time and matter of fact; and I abandon every thing in my book respecting the foundation of the earth, and, generally, all which may be contrary to the narration of Moses."81

Soon after the release of his "Natural History," which included his "Theory of the Earth," he got an official letter (dated January 1751) from the Sorbonne, or Faculty of Theology in Paris, informing him that fourteen statements in his works "were objectionable and against the church's teachings." The first of these disputed passages, and the only one concerning geology, stated: "The waters of the sea have created the mountains and valleys of the land—the waters from the heavens, leveling everything, will eventually hand the entire land over to the sea, and as the sea gradually takes over the land, it will leave behind new continents like the ones we live on." Buffon was politely invited by the College to submit an explanation, or rather a retraction of his unconventional views. 40 He agreed to this, and a general assembly of the Faculty approved his "Declaration," requiring him to publish it in his next work. The document starts with these words: "I declare that I had no intention to contradict the text of Scripture; that I firmly believe everything mentioned about creation, both in terms of the order of events and factual details; and I abandon everything in my book regarding the foundation of the earth, and in general, anything that may contradict the account of Moses."81

The grand principle which Buffon was called upon to renounce was simply this,—that the present mountains and valleys of the earth are due to secondary causes, and that the same causes will in time destroy all the continents, hills, and valleys, and reproduce others like them. Now, whatever may be the defects of many of his views, it is no longer controverted that the present continents are of secondary origin. The doctrine is as firmly established as the earth's rotation on its axis; and that the land now elevated above the level of the sea will not endure forever, is an opinion which gains ground daily, in proportion as we enlarge our experience of the changes now in progress.

The main idea that Buffon was expected to give up was simply this: the current mountains and valleys of the Earth result from secondary causes, and those same causes will eventually destroy all the continents, hills, and valleys, creating new ones like them. Now, regardless of the flaws in many of his ideas, it's no longer disputed that today’s continents have a secondary origin. This belief is as well-established as the Earth’s rotation on its axis, and the idea that the land currently above sea level won’t last forever is gaining traction every day, especially as we expand our understanding of the ongoing changes.

Targioni, 1751.—Targioni, in his voluminous "Travels in Tuscany, 1751 and 1754," labored to fill up the sketch of the geology of that region left by Steno sixty years before. Notwithstanding a want of arrangement and condensation in his memoirs, they contained a rich store of faithful observations. He has not indulged in many general views, but in regard to the origin of valleys, he was opposed to the theory of Buffon, who attributed them principally to submarine currents. The Tuscan naturalist labored to show that both the larger and smaller valleys of the Apennines were excavated by rivers and floods, caused by the bursting of the barriers of lakes, after the retreat of the ocean. He also maintained that the elephants and other quadrupeds, so frequent in the lacustrine and alluvial deposits of Italy, had inhabited that peninsula; and had not been transported thither, as some had conceived, by Hannibal or the Romans, nor by what they were pleased to term "a catastrophe of nature."

Targioni, 1751.—In his extensive "Travels in Tuscany, 1751 and 1754," Targioni worked to complete the geological overview of that region that Steno had started sixty years earlier. Despite lacking organization and brevity in his writings, they offered a wealth of accurate observations. He didn't entertain many broad theories, but when it came to the origin of valleys, he disagreed with Buffon's idea that they were mainly formed by underwater currents. The Tuscan naturalist argued that both the large and small valleys of the Apennines were shaped by rivers and floods triggered by the breaking of lake barriers after the ocean receded. He also asserted that the elephants and other mammals frequently found in Italy's lakebed and riverbank deposits had actually lived on the peninsula, and were not brought there by Hannibal or the Romans, nor by what some called "a catastrophe of nature."

Lehman, 1756.—In the year 1756 the treatise of Lehman, a German mineralogist, and director of the Prussian mines, appeared, who also divided mountains into three classes: the first, those formed with the world, and prior to the creation of animals, and which contained no fragments of other rocks; the second class, those which resulted from the partial destruction of the primary rocks by a general revolution; and a third class, resulting from local revolutions, and in part from the deluge of Noah.

Lehman, 1756.—In 1756, the work of Lehman, a German mineralogist and head of the Prussian mines, was published. He categorized mountains into three types: the first type includes those formed along with the Earth, before the existence of animals, and that have no fragments of other rocks; the second type consists of those created from the partial destruction of primary rocks due to a global upheaval; and the third type arises from local upheavals and partly from Noah's flood.

A French translation of this work appeared in 1759, in the preface of which, the translator displays very enlightened views respecting the operations of earthquakes, as well as of the aqueous causes.82

A French translation of this work was published in 1759, and in the preface, the translator shares some very insightful thoughts about how earthquakes work, as well as the effects of water causes.82

41Gesner, 1758.—In this year Gesner, the botanist, of Zurich, published an excellent treatise on petrifactions, and the changes of the earth which they testify.83 After a detailed enumeration of the various classes of fossils of the animal and vegetable kingdoms, and remarks on the different states in which they are found petrified, he considers the geological phenomena connected with them; observing, that some, like those of Œningen, resembled the testacea, fish, and plants indigenous in the neighboring region;84 while some, such as ammonites, gryphites, belemnites, and other shells, are either of unknown species, or found only in the Indian and other distant seas. In order to elucidate the structure of the earth, he gives sections, from Verenius, Buffon, and others, obtained in digging wells; distinguishes between horizontal and inclined strata; and, in speculating on the causes of these appearances, mentions Donati's examination of the bed of the Adriatic; the filling up of lakes and seas by sediment; the imbedding of shells now in progress; and many known effects of earthquakes, such as the sinking down of districts, or the heaving up of the bed of the sea, so as to form new islands, and lay dry strata containing petrifactions. The ocean, he says, deserts its shores in many countries, as on the borders of the Baltic; but the rate of recession has been so slow in the last 2000 years, that to allow the Apennines, whose summits are filled with marine shells, to emerge to their present height, would have required about 80,000 years,—a lapse of time ten times greater, or more, than the age of the universe. We must therefore refer the phenomenon to the command of the Deity, related by Moses, that "the waters should be gathered together in one place, and the dry land appear." Gesner adopted the views of Leibnitz, to account for the retreat of the primeval ocean: his essay displays much erudition; and the opinions of preceding writers of Italy, Germany, and England, are commented upon with fairness and discrimination.

41Gesner, 1758.—In this year, Gesner, the botanist from Zurich, published an impressive treatise on fossils and the geological changes they reveal. 83 After thoroughly listing various types of fossils from both the animal and plant kingdoms, along with observations on the different states in which they are found petrified, he discusses the geological phenomena related to them. He notes that some fossils, like those from Œningen, are similar to shellfish, fish, and plants native to the surrounding area;84 while others, such as ammonites, gryphites, belemnites, and various shells, belong to unknown species or are found only in distant seas like the Indian Ocean. To shed light on the Earth's structure, he provides cross-sections from Verenius, Buffon, and others, obtained from well diggings; differentiates between horizontal and inclined layers; and speculates on the causes for these formations by referencing Donati's study of the Adriatic seabed, the filling of lakes and oceans with sediment, the ongoing embedding of shells, and well-known earthquake effects, such as land sinking or the rising of the seabed to create new islands and expose layers with fossils. He mentions that the ocean recedes from its shores in many places, like along the Baltic; however, the rate of this retreat has been so gradual over the last 2,000 years that it would have taken around 80,000 years for the Apennines—whose peaks contain marine shells—to reach their current height, a timeframe ten times longer than the universe's age. Therefore, we must attribute this phenomenon to the divine command mentioned by Moses that "the waters should be gathered together in one place, and the dry land appear." Gesner supported Leibnitz's theories to explain the retreat of the ancient ocean; his essay showcases significant knowledge, and he critiques the viewpoints of prior writers from Italy, Germany, and England with fairness and discernment.

Arduino, 1759.—In the year following, Arduino,85 in his memoirs on the mountains of Padua, Vicenza, and Verona, deduced, from original observations, the distinction of rocks into primary, secondary, and tertiary, and showed that in those districts there had been a succession of submarine volcanic eruptions.

Arduino, 1759.—In the following year, Arduino,85 in his writings about the mountains of Padua, Vicenza, and Verona, concluded from original observations that rocks could be categorized into primary, secondary, and tertiary, and demonstrated that those areas had experienced a series of underwater volcanic eruptions.

Michell, 1760.—In the following year (1760) the Rev. John Michell, Woodwardian Professor of Mineralogy at Cambridge, published in the Philosophical Transactions, an Essay on the Cause and Phenomena of Earthquakes.86 His attention had been drawn to this subject by the 42 great earthquake of Lisbon in 1755. He advanced many original and philosophical views respecting the propagation of subterranean movements, and the caverns and fissures wherein steam might be generated. In order to point out the application of his theory to the structure of the globe, he was led to describe the arrangement and disturbance of the strata, their usual horizontality in low countries, and their contortions and fractured state in the neighborhood of mountain chains. He also explained, with surprising accuracy, the relations of the central ridges of older rocks to the "long narrow slips of similar earth, stones, and minerals," which are parallel to these ridges. In his generalizations, derived in great part from his own observations on the geological structure of Yorkshire, he anticipated many of the views more fully developed by later naturalists.

Michell, 1760.—In the following year (1760), Rev. John Michell, Woodwardian Professor of Mineralogy at Cambridge, published an Essay on the Cause and Phenomena of Earthquakes in the Philosophical Transactions.86 His interest in this topic was sparked by the massive earthquake in Lisbon in 1755. He proposed many original and philosophical ideas about how underground movements spread and the caverns and cracks where steam could form. To illustrate how his theory applied to the Earth’s structure, he described how layers of rock are arranged and disturbed, their typical horizontal orientation in low-lying areas, and their twists and breaks near mountain ranges. He also explained, with remarkable accuracy, the connections between the central ridges of older rocks and the "long narrow slips of similar earth, stones, and minerals" that run parallel to these ridges. His generalizations, mostly based on his observations of Yorkshire’s geological structure, foreshadowed many ideas that later naturalists would further elaborate on.

Catcott, 1761.—Michell's papers were entirely free from all physico-theological disquisitions, but some of his contemporaries were still earnestly engaged in defending or impugning the Woodwardian hypothesis. We find many of these writings referred to by Catcott, a Hutchinsonian, who published a "Treatise on the Deluge" in 1761. He labored particularly to refute an explanation offered by his contemporary, Bishop Clayton, of the Mosaic writings. That prelate had declared that the deluge "could not be literally true, save in respect to that part where Noah lived before the flood." Catcott insisted on the universality of the deluge, and referred to traditions of inundations mentioned by ancient writers, or by travellers, in the East Indies, China, South America, and other countries. This part of his book is valuable, although it is not easy to see what bearing the traditions have, if admitted to be authentic, on the Bishop's argument, since no evidence is adduced to prove that the catastrophes were contemporaneous events, while some of them are expressly represented by ancient authors to have occurred in succession.

Catcott, 1761.—Michell's papers completely avoided any discussions on physics and theology, but some of his contemporaries were still actively defending or challenging the Woodwardian hypothesis. Many of these writings are cited by Catcott, a Hutchinsonian, who published a "Treatise on the Deluge" in 1761. He specifically worked to counter an explanation put forth by Bishop Clayton regarding the Mosaic writings. The Bishop had stated that the flood "could not be literally true, except for that part where Noah lived before the flood." Catcott argued for the universality of the flood and referred to accounts of floods mentioned by ancient writers or travelers in the East Indies, China, South America, and other regions. This section of his book is valuable, although it’s not clear how these traditions, if considered authentic, relate to the Bishop's argument, since no evidence is provided to prove that these catastrophes were simultaneous events, while some are explicitly described by ancient authors as having happened in sequence.

Fortis—Odoardi, 1761.—The doctrines of Arduino, above adverted to, were afterwards confirmed by Fortis and Desmarest, in their travels in the same country; and they, as well as Baldassari, labored to complete the history of the Subapennine strata. In the work of Odoardi,87 there was also a clear argument in favor of the distinct ages of the older Apennine strata, and the Subapennine formations of more recent origin. He pointed out that the strata of these two groups were unconformable, and must have been the deposits of different seas at distant periods of time.

Fortis—Odoardi, 1761.—The ideas of Arduino, mentioned earlier, were later confirmed by Fortis and Desmarest during their travels in the same region; they, along with Baldassari, worked to complete the history of the Subapennine layers. In Odoardi's work,87 he also presented a strong argument for the distinct ages of the older Apennine layers and the more recent Subapennine formations. He noted that the layers of these two groups were unconformable, indicating they must have been formed from different seas at different times.

Raspe, 1763.—A history of the new islands, by Raspe, a Hanoverian, 43 appeared in 1763, in Latin.88 In this work, all the authentic accounts of earthquakes which had produced permanent changes on the solid parts of the earth were collected together and examined with judicious criticism. The best systems which had been proposed concerning the ancient history of the globe, both by ancient and modern writers, are reviewed; and the merits and defects of the doctrines of Hooke, Ray, Moro, Buffon, and others, fairly estimated. Great admiration is expressed for the hypothesis of Hooke, and his explanation of the origin of the strata is shown to have been more correct than Moro's, while their theory of the effects of earthquakes was the same. Raspe had not seen Michell's memoirs, and his views concerning the geological structure of the earth were perhaps less enlarged; yet he was able to add many additional arguments in favor of Hook's theory, and to render it, as he said, a nearer approach to what Hooke would have written had he lived in later times. As to the periods wherein all the earthquakes happened, to which we owe the elevation of various parts of our continents and islands, Raspe says he pretends not to assign their duration, still less to defend Hooke's suggestion, that the convulsions almost all took place during the deluge of Noah. He adverts to the apparent indications of the former tropical heat of the climate of Europe, and the changes in the species of animals and plants, as among the most obscure and difficult problems in geology. In regard to the islands raised from the sea, within the times of history or tradition, he declares that some of them were composed of strata containing organic remains, and that they were not, as Buffon had asserted, made of mere volcanic matter. His work concludes with an eloquent exhortation to naturalists to examine the isles which rose, in 1707, in the Grecian Archipelago, and, in 1720, in the Azores, and not to neglect such splendid opportunities of studying nature "in the act of parturition." That Hooke's writings should have been neglected for more than half a century, was matter of astonishment to Raspe; but it is still more wonderful that his own luminous exposition of that theory should, for more than another half century, have excited so little interest.

Raspe, 1763.—A history of the new islands, by Raspe, a Hanoverian, 43 was published in 1763, in Latin.88 In this work, all the authentic accounts of earthquakes that caused permanent changes to the solid parts of the earth were gathered and critically examined. The best theories regarding the earth's ancient history put forth by both ancient and modern authors are reviewed, with a fair assessment of the strengths and weaknesses of the ideas from Hooke, Ray, Moro, Buffon, and others. Great admiration is displayed for Hooke's hypothesis, and his explanation of the origin of the strata is shown to be more accurate than Moro's, although their theories about the effects of earthquakes were similar. Raspe had not encountered Michell's writings, and his understanding of the geological structure of the earth might not have been as broad; however, he was able to present many additional arguments supporting Hooke's theory and made it, as he noted, a more accurate reflection of what Hooke might have written if he lived in later times. Regarding the periods during which all the earthquakes that led to the uplift of various parts of our continents and islands occurred, Raspe claims he doesn't intend to determine their duration, much less defend Hooke's suggestion that most of the upheavals occurred during Noah's flood. He refers to the clear signs of the earlier tropical climate in Europe and the changes in animal and plant species as some of the most obscure and challenging issues in geology. Concerning the islands that emerged from the sea during historical times, he states that some were made of layers containing organic remains, disputing Buffon’s claim that they were simply composed of volcanic material. His work concludes with a powerful appeal to naturalists to study the islands that rose in 1707 in the Greek Archipelago and in 1720 in the Azores, urging them not to miss such fantastic opportunities to observe nature "in the act of giving birth." Raspe expressed amazement that Hooke's writings had been overlooked for more than fifty years, but it is even more surprising that his own insightful explanation of that theory had, for over another fifty years, generated so little interest.

Fuchsel, 1762 and 1773.—Fuchsel, a German physician, published, in 1762, a geological description of the country between the Thuringerwald and the Hartz, and a memoir on the environs of Rudelstadt;89 and afterwards, in 1773, a theoretical work on the ancient history of the earth and of man.90 He had evidently advanced considerably beyond his predecessor Lehman, and was aware of the distinctness, both as to position and fossil contents, of several groups of strata of different ages, corresponding to the secondary formations now recognized by geologists 44 in various parts of Germany. He supposed the European continents to have remained covered by the sea until the formation of the marine strata, called in Germany "muschelkalk," at the same time that the terrestrial plants of many European deposits, attested the existence of dry land which bordered the ancient sea; land which, therefore, must have occupied the place of the present ocean. The pre-existing continent had been gradually swallowed up by the sea, different parts having subsided in succession into subterranean caverns. All the sedimentary strata were originally horizontal, and their present state of derangement must be referred to subsequent oscillations of the ground.

Fuchsel, 1762 and 1773.—Fuchsel, a German physician, published, in 1762, a geological description of the area between the Thuringerwald and the Hartz, along with a memoir on the surroundings of Rudelstadt;89 and later, in 1773, a theoretical work on the ancient history of the earth and humanity.90 He clearly advanced significantly beyond his predecessor Lehman, recognizing the distinct differences, both in location and fossil content, among several groups of strata from various ages, which correspond to the secondary formations now acknowledged by geologists 44 across different regions of Germany. He believed that the European continents were covered by the sea until the creation of the marine layers known in Germany as "muschelkalk," while terrestrial plants in many European deposits indicated the presence of dry land that bordered the ancient sea; land that must have existed where the current ocean is located. The earlier continent had been gradually consumed by the sea, with different areas sinking successively into underground caverns. All the sedimentary layers were initially horizontal, and their current disordered state can be attributed to later shifts in the ground.

As there were plants and animals in the ancient periods, so also there must have been men, but they did not all descend from one pair, but were created at various points on the earth's surface; and the number of these distinct birth-places was as great as are the original languages of nations.

As there were plants and animals in ancient times, there were also humans, but they didn't all come from one pair; they were created at different locations around the world. The number of these distinct birthplace locations was as varied as the original languages of nations.

In the writings of Fuchsel we see a strong desire manifested to explain geological phenomena as far as possible by reference to the agency of known causes; and although some of his speculations were fanciful, his views coincide much more nearly with those now generally adopted, than the theories afterwards promulgated by Werner and his followers.

In Fuchsel's writings, there's a clear desire to explain geological phenomena primarily through known causes. While some of his ideas were quite imaginative, his views align much more closely with the theories that are widely accepted today than with those later promoted by Werner and his followers.

Brander, 1766.—Gustavus Brander published, in 1766, his "Fossilia Hantoniensia," containing excellent figures of fossil shells from the more modern (or Eocene) marine strata of Hampshire. "Various opinions," he says in the preface, "had been entertained concerning the time when and how these bodies became deposited. Some there are who conceive that it might have been effected in a wonderful length of time by a gradual changing and shifting of the sea," &c. But the most common cause assigned is that of "the deluge." This conjecture, he says, even if the universality of the flood be not called in question, is purely hypothetical. In his opinion, fossil animals and testacea were, for the most part, of unknown species; and of such as were known, the living analogues now belonged to southern latitudes.

Brander, 1766.—Gustavus Brander published his "Fossilia Hantoniensia" in 1766, featuring impressive illustrations of fossil shells from the more recent (or Eocene) marine layers of Hampshire. "Various opinions," he states in the preface, "have been held regarding when and how these bodies were deposited. Some believe it could have taken an incredibly long time through a gradual change and shifting of the sea," etc. However, the most commonly suggested reason is "the deluge." He notes that this idea, even if the universality of the flood isn't disputed, is purely speculative. In his view, fossil animals and shells were mostly of unknown species, and those that were recognized had living counterparts primarily found in warmer southern regions.

Soldani, 1780.—Soldani applied successfully his knowledge of zoology to illustrate the history of stratified masses. He explained that microscopic testacea and zoophytes inhabited the depths of the Mediterranean; and that the fossil species were, in like manner, found in those deposits wherein the fineness of their particles, and the absence of pebbles, implied that they were accumulated in a deep sea, or far from shore. This author first remarked the alternation of marine and freshwater strata in the Paris basin.91

Soldani, 1780.—Soldani successfully used his knowledge of zoology to illustrate the history of layered rock formations. He explained that microscopic organisms like testacea and zoophytes lived in the depths of the Mediterranean, and that fossil species were also found in those deposits where the fine particles and lack of pebbles indicated they had formed in deep sea conditions or far from shore. This author was the first to notice the alternation of marine and freshwater layers in the Paris basin.91

Fortis—Testa, 1793.—A lively controversy arose between Fortis and another Italian naturalist, Testa, concerning the fish of Monte Bolca, in 1793. Their letters,92 written with great spirit and elegance, show that they were aware that a large proportion of the Subapennine shells were 45 identical with living species, and some of them with species now living in the torrid zone. Fortis proposed a somewhat fanciful conjecture, that when the volcanoes of the Vicentin were burning, the waters of the Adriatic had a higher temperature; and in this manner, he said, the shells of warmer regions may once have peopled their own seas. But Testa was disposed to think that these species of testacea were still common to their own and to equinoctial seas; for many, he said, once supposed to be confined to hotter regions, had been afterwards discovered in the Mediterranean.93

Fortis—Testa, 1793.—A lively debate erupted between Fortis and another Italian naturalist, Testa, about the fish of Monte Bolca in 1793. Their letters,92 written with great enthusiasm and elegance, show that they recognized that a significant number of the Subapennine shells were 45 the same as living species, and some of them matched species currently found in tropical regions. Fortis put forward a somewhat imaginative theory, suggesting that when the volcanoes in Vicentin were active, the waters of the Adriatic had a higher temperature; he argued that this could explain how shells from warmer regions might have once filled their own seas. However, Testa believed that these species of testacea were still common in both their own and equatorial seas; he pointed out that many species once thought to be limited to warmer regions had later been found in the Mediterranean.93

Cortesi—Spallanzani—Wallerius—Whitehurst.—While these Italian naturalists, together with Cortesi and Spallanzani, were busily engaged in pointing out the analogy between the deposits of modern and ancient seas, and the habits and arrangement of their organic inhabitants, and while some progress was making, in the same country, in investigating the ancient and modern volcanic rocks, some of the most original observers among the English and German writers, Whitehurst94 and Wallerius, were wasting their strength in contending, according to the old Woodwardian hypothesis, that all the strata were formed by Noah's deluge. But Whitehurst's description of the rocks of Derbyshire was most faithful; and he atoned for false theoretical views, by providing data for their refutation.

Cortesi—Spallanzani—Wallerius—Whitehurst.—While these Italian naturalists, along with Cortesi and Spallanzani, were actively highlighting the similarities between the deposits of modern and ancient seas, as well as the habits and arrangement of their living organisms, and while some progress was being made in the same country on studying ancient and modern volcanic rocks, some of the most original observers among English and German writers, Whitehurst94 and Wallerius, were wasting their efforts arguing, based on the old Woodwardian hypothesis, that all the layers were created by Noah's flood. However, Whitehurst's description of the rocks in Derbyshire was extremely accurate, and he made up for his incorrect theoretical views by providing data that contradicted them.

Pallas—Saussure.—Towards the close of the eighteenth century, the idea of distinguishing the mineral masses on our globe into separate groups, and studying their relations, began to be generally diffused. Pallas and Saussure were among the most celebrated whose labors contributed to this end. After an attentive examination of the two great mountain chains of Siberia, Pallas announced the result, that the granitic rocks were in the middle, the schistose at their sides, and the limestones again on the outside of these; and this he conceived would prove a general law in the formation of all chains composed chiefly of primary rocks.95

Pallas—Saussure.—By the end of the eighteenth century, the idea of classifying the mineral masses on our planet into distinct groups and examining their relationships was becoming widespread. Pallas and Saussure were among the most renowned contributors to this effort. After carefully studying the two major mountain ranges of Siberia, Pallas reported that the granitic rocks were situated in the center, the schistose rocks were on the sides, and the limestones were on the outer layer; he proposed that this would serve as a general principle in the formation of all mountain ranges primarily made up of basic rocks.95

In his "Travels in Russia," in 1793 and 1794, he made many geological observations on the recent strata near the Wolga and the Caspian, and adduced proofs of the greater extent of the latter sea at no distant era in the earth's history. His memoir on the fossil bones of Siberia attracted attention to some of the most remarkable phenomena in geology. He stated that he had found a rhinoceros entire in the frozen soil, with its skin and flesh: an elephant, found afterwards in a mass 46 of ice on the shore of the North Sea, removed all doubt as to the accuracy of so wonderful a discovery.96

In his "Travels in Russia," during 1793 and 1794, he made numerous geological observations on the recent layers near the Volga and the Caspian, and provided evidence of the larger size of the latter sea at some point in the Earth’s history. His report on the fossil bones of Siberia highlighted some of the most remarkable events in geology. He mentioned finding an entire rhinoceros in the frozen ground, complete with its skin and flesh; later, an elephant discovered in a block of ice on the North Sea shore confirmed the validity of such an amazing find.46

The subjects relating to natural history which engaged the attention of Pallas, were too multifarious to admit of his devoting a large share of his labors exclusively to geology. Saussure, on the other hand, employed the chief portion of his time in studying the structure of the Alps and Jura, and he provided valuable data for those who followed him. He did not pretend to deduce any general system from his numerous and interesting observations; and the few theoretical opinions which escaped from him, seem, like those of Pallas, to have been chiefly derived from the cosmological speculations of preceding writers.

The topics related to natural history that Pallas focused on were too varied for him to dedicate a significant amount of his work solely to geology. In contrast, Saussure spent most of his time studying the structure of the Alps and Jura, offering valuable information for future researchers. He didn’t claim to form any overarching system from his many intriguing observations, and the few theoretical ideas he shared appeared, much like those of Pallas, to be primarily based on the cosmological theories of earlier authors.


CHAPTER IV.

HISTORY OF THE PROGRESS OF GEOLOGY—continued.

Werner's application of geology to the art of mining—Excursive character of his lectures—Enthusiasm of his pupils—His authority—His theoretical errors—Desmarest's Map and Description of Auvergne—Controversy between the Vulcanists and Neptunists—Intemperance of the rival sects—Hutton's Theory of the earth—His discovery of granite veins—Originality of his views—Why opposed—Playfair's illustrations—Influence of Voltaire's writings on geology—Imputations cast on the Huttonians by Williams, Kirwan, and De Luc—Smith's Map of England—Geological Society of London—Progress of the science in France—Growing importance of the study of organic remains.

Werner's use of geology in mining—The engaging nature of his lectures—The excitement of his students—His influence—His theoretical mistakes—Desmarest's Map and Description of Auvergne—The debate between the Vulcanists and Neptunists—The excesses of the rival factions—Hutton's Theory of the Earth—His discovery of granite veins—The uniqueness of his ideas—The reasons for opposition—Playfair's examples—The impact of Voltaire's writings on geology—Criticism of the Huttonians by Williams, Kirwan, and De Luc—Smith's Map of England—The Geological Society of London—Advancements in the science in France—The increasing significance of studying organic remains.

Werner.—The art of mining has long been taught in France, Germany, and Hungary, in scientific institutions established for that purpose, where mineralogy has always been a principal branch of instruction.

Werner.—Mining has been taught for a long time in France, Germany, and Hungary, in scientific institutions set up for that purpose, where mineralogy has consistently been a key area of study.

Werner was named, in 1775, professor of that science in the "School of Mines," at Freyberg, in Saxony. He directed his attention not merely to the composition and external characters of minerals, but also to what he termed "geognosy," or the natural position of minerals in particular rocks, together with the grouping of those rocks, their geographical distribution, and various relations. The phenomena observed in the structure of the globe had hitherto served for little else than to furnish interesting topics for philosophical discussion; but when Werner pointed out their application to the practical purposes of mining, they were instantly regarded by a large class of men as an essential part of their professional education, and from that time the science was cultivated in Europe more ardently and systematically. Werner's mind was at once imaginative and richly stored with miscellaneous knowledge. He associated every thing with his favorite science, and in his excursive 47lectures, he pointed out all the economical uses of minerals, and their application to medicine; the influence of the mineral composition of rocks upon the soil, and of the soil upon the resources, wealth, and civilization of man. The vast sandy plains of Tartary and Africa, he would say, retained their inhabitants in the shape of wandering shepherds; the granitic mountains and the low calcareous and alluvial plains gave rise to different manners, degrees of wealth, and intelligence. The history even of languages, and the migration of tribes, had been determined by the direction of particular strata. The qualities of certain stones used in building would lead him to descant on the architecture of different ages and nations; and the physical geography of a country frequently invited him to treat of military tactics. The charm of his manners and his eloquence kindled enthusiasm in the minds of his pupils; and many, who had intended at first only to acquire a slight knowledge of mineralogy, when they had once heard him, devoted themselves to it as the business of their lives. In a few years, a small school of mines, before unheard of in Europe, was raised to the rank of a great university; and men already distinguished in science studied the German language, and came from the most distant countries to hear the great oracle of geology.97

Werner was appointed in 1775 as a professor at the "School of Mines" in Freyberg, Saxony. He focused not only on the composition and characteristics of minerals but also on what he called "geognosy," which is the natural positioning of minerals within specific rocks, along with the grouping of those rocks, their geographical distribution, and various connections. The phenomena observed in the Earth’s structure had mainly served as interesting topics for philosophical debates until Werner highlighted their practical applications in mining. This immediately made them essential for many people’s professional education, and from then on, the science was pursued in Europe with much greater enthusiasm and organization. Werner had a creative mind filled with diverse knowledge. He connected everything to his favorite science, and in his broad-ranging lectures, he pointed out the economic uses of minerals and their applications in medicine; the effects of rock mineral compositions on soil, and how soil influenced human resources, wealth, and civilization. He would say that the vast sandy plains of Tartary and Africa kept their inhabitants as wandering shepherds; the granitic mountains and the low calcareous and alluvial plains led to different lifestyles, levels of wealth, and intelligence. Even the history of languages and the migration of tribes was shaped by the orientation of specific layers. The characteristics of certain stones used in construction prompted him to discuss the architecture of various eras and nations; and the physical geography of a region often encouraged him to address military strategies. The charm of his personality and his eloquence inspired enthusiasm in his students. Many who initially intended to gain only a basic understanding of mineralogy, after hearing him speak, dedicated themselves to it as their life's work. In a few years, a small school of mines, previously unknown in Europe, grew into a renowned university; and already prominent figures in science learned German and traveled from far-off countries to listen to the great authority on geology.97

Werner had a great antipathy to the mechanical labor of writing, and, with the exception of a valuable treatise on metalliferous veins, he could never be persuaded to pen more than a few brief memoirs, and those containing no development of his general views. Although the natural modesty of his disposition was excessive, approaching even to timidity, he indulged in the most bold and sweeping generalizations, and he inspired all his scholars with a most implicit faith in his doctrines. Their admiration of his genius, and the feelings of gratitude and friendship which they all felt for him, were not undeserved; but the supreme authority usurped by him over the opinions of his contemporaries, was eventually prejudicial to the progress of the science; so much so, as greatly to counterbalance the advantages which it derived from his exertions. If it be true that delivery be the first, second, and third requisite in a popular orator, it is no less certain, that to travel is of first, second, and third importance to those who desire to originate just and comprehensive views concerning the structure of our globe. Now Werner had not travelled to distant countries; he had merely explored a small portion of Germany, and conceived, and persuaded others to believe, that the whole surface of our planet, and all the mountain chains in the world, were made after the model of his own province. It became a ruling object of ambition in the minds of his pupils to confirm the generalizations of their great master, and to discover in the most distant parts of the globe his "universal formations," which he supposed had been each in succession simultaneously precipitated over the whole earth from a common menstruum, or "chaotic fluid." It now appears 48that the Saxon professor had misinterpreted many of the most important appearances even in the immediate neighborhood of Freyberg. Thus, for example, within a day's journey of his school, the porphyry, called by him primitive, has been found not only to send forth veins or dikes through strata of the coal formation, but to overlie them in mass. The granite of the Hartz mountains, on the other hand, which he supposed to be the nucleus of the chain, is now well known to traverse the other beds, as near Goslar; and still nearer Freyberg, in the Erzgebirge, the mica slate does not mantle round the granite as was supposed, but abuts abruptly against it. Fragments, also, of the greywacké slate, containing organic remains, have recently been found entangled in the granite of the Hartz, by M. de Seckendorf.98

Werner had a strong dislike for the tedious task of writing. Aside from a valuable paper on metalliferous veins, he was never convinced to write more than a few short accounts, none of which fully explored his broader ideas. Although his natural modesty was extreme, bordering on timidity, he made bold and sweeping generalizations that instilled his students with unwavering faith in his theories. Their admiration for his intellect, along with the feelings of gratitude and friendship they all felt for him, were well-deserved; however, his total dominance over the opinions of his contemporaries ended up hindering the advancement of science, enough to overshadow the benefits his efforts provided. If it's true that delivery is the most important trait for a popular speaker, it's equally clear that traveling is crucial for those who want to develop accurate and comprehensive views about the structure of our planet. Yet, Werner had not traveled far; he had only explored a small part of Germany and convinced himself and others that the entire surface of the Earth and all mountain ranges were modeled after his own region. His students became obsessed with proving their great master's theories, seeking out his so-called "universal formations" in the farthest corners of the globe, which he believed had all been formed simultaneously from a common "chaotic fluid." It now appears that the Saxon professor misunderstood many of the key features even around Freyberg. For example, within a day's journey from his school, the porphyry he called primitive has been found to both send veins into the coal formations and lie above them. Contrary to his belief, the granite of the Hartz mountains, which he thought was the core of the chain, is now known to cut through other layers, such as near Goslar. Even closer to Freyberg, in the Erzgebirge, the mica slate does not surround the granite as he assumed but ends abruptly against it. Additionally, fragments of greywacké slate with organic remains have recently been discovered embedded in the granite of the Hartz, by M. de Seckendorf.98

The principal merit of Werner's system of instruction consisted in steadily directing the attention of his scholars to the constant relations of superposition of certain mineral groups; but he had been anticipated, as has been shown in the last chapter, in the discovery of this general law, by several geologists in Italy and elsewhere; and his leading divisions of the secondary strata were at the same time, and independently, made the basis of an arrangement of the British strata by our countryman, William Smith, to whose work I shall refer in the sequel.

The main value of Werner's teaching method was in keeping his students focused on the consistent relationships of superposition among certain groups of minerals. However, as noted in the last chapter, he was preempted in discovering this general principle by several geologists in Italy and other places. Additionally, his key classifications of the secondary strata were simultaneously developed, independently, as the foundation for organizing the British strata by our fellow countryman, William Smith, whose work I will reference later.

Controversy between the Vulcanists and Neptunists.—In regard to basalt and other igneous rocks, Werner's theory was original, but it was also extremely erroneous. The basalts of Saxony and Hesse, to which his observations were chiefly confined, consisted of tabular masses capping the hills, and not connected with the levels of existing valleys, like many in Auvergne and the Vivarais. These basalts, and all other rocks of the same family in other countries, were, according to him, chemical precipitates from water. He denied that they were the products of submarine volcanoes; and even taught that, in the primeval ages of the world, there were no volcanoes. His theory was opposed, in a twofold sense, to the doctrine of the permanent agency of the same causes in nature; for not only did he introduce, without scruple, many imaginary causes supposed to have once effected great revolutions in the earth, and then to have become extinct, but new ones also were feigned to have come into play in modern times; and, above all, that most violent instrument of change, the agency of subterranean heat.

Controversy between the Vulcanists and Neptunists.—Regarding basalt and other igneous rocks, Werner's theory was groundbreaking, but it was also really wrong. The basalts of Saxony and Hesse, which were the focus of his observations, were tabular formations on top of hills, not linked to the levels of existing valleys like many found in Auvergne and Vivarais. According to him, these basalts and all similar rocks in other regions were chemical deposits from water. He rejected the idea that they were produced by underwater volcanoes and even claimed that, in the early ages of the Earth, there were no volcanoes at all. His theory contradicted the idea that the same natural processes operate consistently over time, as he introduced many imaginary causes that supposedly caused significant changes to the Earth and then became extinct. He also invented new causes said to be active in modern times, including the powerful force of subterranean heat.

So early as 1768, before Werner had commenced his mineralogical studies, Raspe had truly characterized the basalts of Hesse as of igneous origin. Arduino, we have seen, had pointed out numerous varieties of trap-rock in the Vicentin as analogous to volcanic products, and as distinctly referable to ancient submarine eruptions. Desmarest, as before stated, had, in company with Fortis, examined the Vicentin in 1766, and confirmed Arduino's views. In 1772, Banks, Solander, and Troil compared the columnar basalt of Hecla with that of the Hebrides. Collini, 49in 1774, recognized the true nature of the igneous rocks on the Rhine, between Andernach and Bonn. In 1775, Guettard visited the Vivarais, and established the relation of basaltic currents to lavas. Lastly, in 1779, Faujas published his description of the volcanoes of the Vivarais and Velay, and showed how the streams of basalt had poured out from craters which still remain in a perfect state.99

So early as 1768, before Werner started his mineralogical studies, Raspe accurately described the basalts of Hesse as being of volcanic origin. Arduino had noted many types of trap-rock in the Vicentin that were similar to volcanic products and clearly related to ancient underwater eruptions. Desmarest, as mentioned earlier, along with Fortis, examined the Vicentin in 1766 and confirmed Arduino's views. In 1772, Banks, Solander, and Troil compared the columnar basalt of Hecla with that of the Hebrides. Collini, 49 in 1774, recognized the true nature of the volcanic rocks along the Rhine, between Andernach and Bonn. In 1775, Guettard visited the Vivarais and established the connection between basaltic flows and lavas. Finally, in 1779, Faujas published his description of the volcanoes of the Vivarais and Velay, showing how the streams of basalt had poured out from craters that are still in perfect condition.99

Desmarest.—When sound opinions had thus for twenty years prevailed in Europe concerning the true nature of the ancient trap-rocks, Werner by his simple dictum caused a retrograde movement, and not only overturned the true theory, but substituted for it one of the most unphilosophical that can well be imagined. The continued ascendancy of his dogmas on this subject was the more astonishing, because a variety of new and striking facts were daily accumulated in favor of the correct opinions previously entertained. Desmarest, after a careful examination of Auvergne, pointed out, first, the most recent volcanoes which had their craters still entire, and their streams of lava conforming to the level of the present river-courses. He then showed that there were others of an intermediate epoch, whose craters were nearly effaced, and whose lavas were less intimately connected with the present valleys; and, lastly, that there were volcanic rocks, still more ancient, without any discernible craters or scoriæ, and bearing the closest analogy to rocks in other parts of Europe, the igneous origin of which was denied by the school of Freyberg.100

Desmarest.—After sound opinions had been established in Europe for twenty years about the true nature of ancient trap-rocks, Werner caused a backward shift with his simple assertion. He not only overturned the correct theory but replaced it with one of the most illogical theories imaginable. The ongoing dominance of his beliefs on this topic was particularly surprising, given that new and compelling facts were continually being gathered that supported the accurate opinions previously held. Desmarest, after thoroughly examining Auvergne, first pointed out the most recent volcanoes that still had intact craters and lava flows that matched the current river levels. He then indicated the existence of intermediate volcanoes, whose craters were nearly worn away and whose lava flows were less directly connected to the existing valleys. Finally, he identified even older volcanic rocks that had no visible craters or scoriae, showing a strong resemblance to rocks found in other parts of Europe, whose igneous origin was rejected by the Freyberg school.100

Desmarest's map of Auvergne was a work of uncommon merit. He first made a trigonometrical survey of the district, and delineated its physical geography with minute accuracy and admirable graphic power. He contrived, at the same time, to express without the aid of colors, many geological details, including the different ages and sometimes even the structure, of the volcanic rocks, and distinguishing them from the fresh-water and the granitic. They alone who have carefully studied Auvergne, and traced the different lava streams from their craters to their termination,—the various isolated basaltic cappings,—the relation of some lavas to the present valleys,—-the absence of such relations in others,—can appreciate the extraordinary fidelity of this elaborate work. No other district of equal dimensions in Europe exhibits, perhaps, so beautiful and varied a series of phenomena; and, fortunately, Desmarest possessed at once the mathematical knowledge required for the construction of a map, skill in mineralogy, and a power of original generalization.

Desmarest's map of Auvergne was an impressive piece of work. He first conducted a trigonometrical survey of the area and depicted its physical geography with remarkable accuracy and excellent graphic skill. At the same time, he managed to detail many geological aspects, such as the different ages and even the structure of the volcanic rocks, all without using colors and distinguishing them from the freshwater and granitic ones. Only those who have carefully studied Auvergne and traced the different lava flows from their craters to where they end—along with the various isolated basalt formations, the connections of some lavas to the current valleys, and the lack of such connections in others—can truly appreciate the incredible detail of this comprehensive work. No other area of similar size in Europe showcases such a beautiful and diverse range of phenomena; luckily, Desmarest had the mathematical knowledge needed for map-making, expertise in mineralogy, and a knack for original generalization.

Dolomieu—Montlosier.—Dolomieu, another of Werner's contemporaries, had found prismatic basalt among the ancient lavas of Etna; and, in 1784, had observed the alternations of submarine lavas and calcareous strata in the Val di Noto, in Sicily.101 In 1790, also, he described similar phenomena in the Vicentin and in the Tyrol.102 Montlosier published, 50in 1788, an essay on the theories of volcanoes of Auvergne, combining accurate local observations with comprehensive views. Notwithstanding this mass of evidence the scholars of Werner were prepared to support his opinions to their utmost extent; maintaining, in the fulness of their faith, that even obsidian was an aqueous precipitate. As they were blinded by their veneration for the great teacher, they were impatient of opposition, and soon imbibed the spirit of a faction; and their opponents, the Vulcanists, were not long in becoming contaminated with the same intemperate zeal. Ridicule and irony were weapons more frequently employed than argument by the rival sects, till at last the controversy was carried on with a degree of bitterness almost unprecedented in questions of physical science. Desmarest alone, who had long before provided ample materials for refuting such a theory, kept aloof from the strife; and whenever a zealous Neptunist wished to draw the old man into an argument, he was satisfied with replying, "Go and see."103

Dolomieu—Montlosier.—Dolomieu, another contemporary of Werner, discovered prismatic basalt among the ancient lavas of Etna. In 1784, he noted the layers of underwater lavas and limestone in the Val di Noto, Sicily.101 In 1790, he also described similar phenomena in the Vicentin and Tyrol.102 Montlosier published an essay in 1788 on volcanic theories in Auvergne, combining detailed local observations with broader perspectives. Despite this wealth of evidence, Werner's followers were determined to defend his views to the fullest, insisting even that obsidian was a product of water precipitation. Blinded by their admiration for their esteemed mentor, they were intolerant of opposition and quickly became a faction; their rivals, the Vulcanists, soon fell into the same extreme enthusiasm. Rather than using arguments, both groups employed ridicule and sarcasm until the debate became bitter, almost unprecedented in the realm of physical science. Only Desmarest, who had long since gathered enough evidence to refute such a theory, stayed out of the conflict; whenever an eager Neptunist tried to engage him in a debate, he simply replied, "Go and see."103

Hutton, 1788.—It would be contrary to all analogy, in matters of graver import, that a war should rage with such fury on the Continent, and that the inhabitants of our island should not mingle in the affray. Although in England the personal influence of Werner was wanting to stimulate men to the defence of the weaker side of the question, they contrived to find good reason for espousing the Wernerian errors with great enthusiasm. In order to explain the peculiar motives which led many to enter, even with party feeling, into this contest, it will be necessary to present the reader with a sketch of the views unfolded by Hutton, a contemporary of the Saxon geologist. The former naturalist had been educated as a physician, but declining the practice of medicine, he resolved, when young, to remain content with the small independence inherited from his father, and thenceforth to give his undivided attention to scientific pursuits. He resided at Edinburgh, where he enjoyed the society of many men of high attainments, who loved him for the simplicity of his manners, and the sincerity of his character. His application was unwearied; and he made frequent tours through different parts of England and Scotland, acquiring considerable skill as a mineralogist, and consequently arriving at grand and comprehensive views in geology. He communicated the results of his observations unreservedly, and with the fearless spirit of one who was conscious that love of truth was the sole stimulus of his exertions. When at length he had matured his views, he published, in 1788, his "Theory of the Earth,"104 and the same, afterwards more fully developed in a separate work, in 1795. This treatise was the first in which geology was declared to be in no way concerned about "questions as to the origin of things;" the first in which an attempt was made to dispense entirely with all hypothetical causes, and to explain the former changes of the earth's crust by reference exclusively to natural agents. Hutton 51labored to give fixed principles to geology, as Newton had succeeded in doing to astronomy; but, in the former science, too little progress had been made towards furnishing the necessary data, to enable any philosopher, however great his genius, to realize so noble a project.

Hutton, 1788.—It would go against all logic, especially in serious matters, that a war could rage so intensely on the Continent while the people of our island stayed out of it. Even though England lacked the personal influence of Werner to motivate people to defend the weaker side of the argument, they managed to find enough reasons to passionately support the Wernerian ideas. To explain the unique motivations that drove many to participate in this conflict, even with bias, it’s essential to provide a brief overview of Hutton's views, a contemporary of the Saxon geologist. Hutton had been trained as a doctor but chose to forgo a medical career, deciding when he was young to be satisfied with the modest inheritance from his father and to focus fully on scientific work. He lived in Edinburgh, where he was surrounded by many highly accomplished individuals who appreciated him for his straightforward nature and genuine character. He worked tirelessly, frequently traveling across various parts of England and Scotland, developing substantial expertise as a mineralogist, which led him to have broad and insightful views on geology. He shared the findings from his studies openly, driven by a sincere love for truth as his sole motivation. Once he had refined his ideas, he published his "Theory of the Earth" in 1788,104 which he later elaborated on in a separate work in 1795. This was the first work to claim that geology wasn't concerned with "questions about the origin of things;" it was the first attempt to completely eliminate hypothetical causes and explain the past changes of the Earth's crust solely through natural agents. Hutton51strived to establish fixed principles for geology, much like Newton did for astronomy; however, in geology, insufficient progress had been made to provide the necessary data for any philosopher, no matter how brilliant, to achieve such an ambitious goal.

Huttonian theory.—"The ruins of an older world," said Hutton, "are visible in the present structure of our planet; and the strata which now compose our continents have been once beneath the sea, and were formed out of the waste of pre-existing continents. The same forces are still destroying, by chemical decomposition or mechanical violence, even the hardest rocks, and transporting the materials to the sea, where they are spread out, and form strata analogous to those of more ancient date. Although loosely deposited along the bottom of the ocean, they become afterwards altered and consolidated by volcanic heat, and then heaved up, fractured, and contorted."

Huttonian theory.—"The remnants of an ancient world," Hutton said, "can be seen in the current structure of our planet; the layers that now make up our continents were once under the sea and formed from the debris of older continents. The same forces are still destroying, through chemical breakdown or mechanical force, even the toughest rocks, and transporting the materials to the sea, where they are spread out and create layers similar to those from earlier periods. Although loosely settled at the ocean floor, they eventually change and become solidified by volcanic heat, and then pushed up, fractured, and twisted."

Although Hutton had never explored any region of active volcanoes, he had convinced himself that basalt and many other trap-rocks were of igneous origin, and that many of them had been injected in a melted state through fissures in the older strata. The compactness of these rocks, and their different aspect from that of ordinary lava, he attributed to their having cooled down under the pressure of the sea; and in order to remove the objections started against this theory, his friend, Sir James Hall, instituted a most curious and instructive series of chemical experiments, illustrating the crystalline arrangement and texture assumed by melted matter cooled under high pressure.

Although Hutton had never explored any area with active volcanoes, he had convinced himself that basalt and many other trap rocks were of igneous origin, and that many of them had been pushed up in a melted state through cracks in the older layers. He explained the compactness of these rocks and their different appearance compared to regular lava as being due to their cooling under the pressure of the sea. To address the objections raised against this theory, his friend, Sir James Hall, conducted a fascinating and informative series of chemical experiments demonstrating the crystalline structure and texture formed by melted materials that cool under high pressure.

The absence of stratification in granite, and its analogy, in mineral character, to rocks which he deemed of igneous origin, led Hutton to conclude that granite also must have been formed from matter in fusion; and this inference he felt could not be fully confirmed, unless he discovered at the contact of granite and other strata a repetition of the phenomena exhibited so constantly by the trap-rocks. Resolved to try his theory by this test, he went to the Grampians, and surveyed the line of junction of the granite and superincumbent stratified masses, until he found in Glen Tilt, in 1785, the most clear and unequivocal proofs in support of his views. Veins of red granite are there seen branching out from the principal mass, and traversing the black micaceous schist and primary limestone. The intersected stratified rocks are so distinct in color and appearance as to render the example in that locality most striking, and the alteration of the limestone in contact was very analogous to that produced by trap veins on calcareous strata. This verification of his system filled him with delight, and called forth such marks of joy and exultation, that the guides who accompanied him, says his biographer, were convinced that he must have discovered a vein of silver or gold.105 He was aware that the same theory would not explain the origin of the primary schists, but these he called primary, rejecting the term primitive, and was disposed to consider them as sedimentary rocks al52tered by heat, and that they originated in some other form from the waste of previously existing rocks.

The lack of layers in granite, along with its similar mineral characteristics to rocks he believed were of volcanic origin, led Hutton to conclude that granite must also have formed from molten material. He thought this conclusion couldn’t be fully validated unless he found a repetition of the phenomena seen in trap rocks at the boundary between granite and other layers. Determined to test his theory, he traveled to the Grampians and examined the junction between the granite and the overlying layered rocks until he discovered, in Glen Tilt in 1785, clear and undeniable evidence supporting his ideas. There, veins of red granite branch out from the main mass and cut through black micaceous schist and primary limestone. The intersected layered rocks are so distinct in color and appearance that this particular example stands out, and the change in the limestone at the contact is very similar to what trap veins do to calcareous layers. This confirmation of his theory thrilled him and led to such expressions of joy and excitement that the guides who were with him, according to his biographer, thought he must have found a vein of silver or gold.105 He recognized that the same theory wouldn't explain the origin of the primary schists, which he referred to as primary, rejecting the term primitive, and he was inclined to view them as sedimentary rocks altered by heat, suggesting they originated in some other form from the erosion of previously existing rocks.

By this important discovery of granite veins, to which he had been led by fair induction from an independent class of facts, Hutton prepared the way for the greatest innovation of the systems of his predecessors. Vallisneri had pointed out the general fact that there were certain fundamental rocks which contained no organic remains, and which he supposed to have been formed before the creation of living beings. Moro, Generelli, and other Italian writers, embraced the same doctrine; and Lehman regarded the mountains called by him primitive, as parts of the original nucleus of the globe. The same tenet was an article of faith in the school of Freyberg; and if any one ventured to doubt the possibility of our being enabled to carry back our researches to the creation of the present order of things, the granitic rocks were triumphantly appealed to. On them seemed written, in legible characters, the memorable inscription—

By discovering granite veins, which he reached through solid reasoning based on a separate set of facts, Hutton paved the way for a major shift in the theories of those before him. Vallisneri highlighted that certain fundamental rocks had no organic remains and believed they formed before life existed. Moro, Generelli, and other Italian authors supported this idea; Lehman viewed the mountains he called primitive as parts of the Earth's original core. This belief was also held strongly by the Freyberg school; if anyone dared to question the possibility of tracing our research back to the creation of the current world, the granitic rocks were confidently pointed to. They seemed to bear a clear inscription—

"Dinanzi a me non fur cose create Se non eterne;"106

"Before me, nothing was created Except for eternal things;"106

and no small sensation was excited when Hutton seemed, with unhallowed hand, desirous to erase characters already regarded by many as sacred. "In the economy of the world," said the Scotch geologist, "I can find no traces of a beginning, no prospect of an end;" a declaration the more startling when coupled with the doctrine, that all past ages on the globe had been brought about by the slow agency of existing causes. The imagination was first fatigued and overpowered by endeavoring to conceive the immensity of time required for the annihilation of whole continents by so insensible a process; and when the thoughts had wandered through these interminable periods, no resting-place was assigned in the remotest distance. The oldest rocks were represented to be of a derivative nature, the last of an antecedent series, and that, perhaps, one of many pre-existing worlds. Such views of the immensity of past time, like those unfolded by the Newtonian philosophy in regard to space, were too vast to awaken ideas of sublimity unmixed with a painful sense of our incapacity to conceive a plan of such infinite extent. Worlds are seen beyond worlds immeasurably distant from each other, and, beyond them all, innumerable other systems are faintly traced on the confines of the visible universe.

and there was quite a sensation when Hutton seemed eager to wipe away symbols that many already considered sacred. "In the scheme of the world," said the Scottish geologist, "I can't find any signs of a beginning or any hope for an end;" a statement that became even more shocking when paired with the belief that all of Earth's past eras had come about through the slow action of present-day forces. The mind was first exhausted and overwhelmed by trying to grasp the immense amount of time needed to completely erase entire continents through such a gradual process; and when thoughts wandered through those endless stretches of time, there was no point of rest even in the farthest reaches. The oldest rocks were said to be of a derivative nature, the last in a previous series, and possibly one of many existing worlds. Such ideas about the vastness of past time, like those revealed by Newtonian philosophy regarding space, were too immense to inspire feelings of awe without also evoking a painful awareness of our inability to grasp a plan of such infinite scale. Worlds are seen beyond worlds, immeasurably far from one another, and beyond all of them, countless other systems are faintly traced at the edges of the visible universe.

The characteristic feature of the Huttonian theory was, as before hinted, the exclusion of all causes not supposed to belong to the present order of nature. But Hutton had made no step beyond Hooke, Moro, and Raspe, in pointing out in what manner the laws now governing subterranean movements might bring about geological changes, if sufficient time be allowed. On the contrary, he seems to have fallen far short of some of their views, especially when he refused to attribute any part 53of the external configuration of the earth's crust to subsidence. He imagined that the continents were first gradually destroyed by aqueous degradation; and when their ruins had furnished materials for new continents, they were upheaved by violent convulsions. He therefore required alternate periods of general disturbance and repose; and such he believed had been, and would forever be, the course of nature.

The main aspect of Hutton's theory was, as previously mentioned, that it excluded all causes that are not thought to belong to the current natural order. However, Hutton didn't go beyond what Hooke, Moro, and Raspe had pointed out about how the laws that govern underground movements could lead to geological changes, given enough time. In fact, he seemed to fall short of some of their ideas, particularly when he declined to link any part of the earth's crust's external features to subsidence. He believed that the continents were initially worn down gradually by water erosion; and after their remains provided materials for new continents, they were pushed up by powerful upheavals. Therefore, he argued that there needed to be alternating periods of significant disruption and calm; and he believed this had been and would always be the natural order.

Generelli, in his exposition of Moro's system, had made a far nearer approximation towards reconciling geological appearances with the state of nature as known to us; for while he agreed with Hutton, that the decay and reproduction of rocks were always in progress, proceeding with the utmost uniformity, the learned Carmelite represented the repairs of mountains by elevation from below to be effected by an equally constant and synchronous operation. Neither of these theories, considered singly, satisfies all the conditions of the great problem, which a geologist, who rejects cosmological causes, is called upon to solve; but they probably contain together the germs of a perfect system. There can be no doubt, that periods of disturbance and repose have followed each other in succession in every region of the globe; but it may be equally true, that the energy of the subterranean movements has been always uniform as regards the whole earth. The force of earthquakes may for a cycle of years have been invariably confined, as it is now, to large but determinate spaces, and may then have gradually shifted its position, so that another region, which had for ages been at rest, became in its turn the grand theatre of action.

Generelli, in his explanation of Moro's system, came closer to reconciling geological features with the state of nature as we know it. While he agreed with Hutton that the decay and reproduction of rocks are always ongoing and occur with great consistency, the knowledgeable Carmelite suggested that the rebuilding of mountains through uplift from below happens through an equally constant and simultaneous process. Neither of these theories, considered on their own, fully meets all the requirements of the major problem that a geologist who dismisses cosmological causes is tasked with solving; however, together they likely hold the seeds of a perfect system. There’s no doubt that periods of disruption and calm have alternated in every part of the world; but it may also be true that the force of the underground movements has always been consistent with respect to the whole earth. The intensity of earthquakes might have been restricted for a number of years, just as it is now, to large but defined areas, and then gradually moved so that another region, which had been quiet for centuries, became the main stage for activity.

Playfair's illustrations of Hutton.—The explanation proposed by Hutton, and by Playfair, the illustrator of his theory, respecting the origin of valleys and of alluvial accumulations, was also very imperfect. They ascribed none of the inequalities of the earth's surface to movements which accompanied the upheaving of the land, imagining that valleys in general were formed in the course of ages by the rivers now flowing in them; while they seem not to have reflected on the excavating and transporting power which the waves of the ocean might exert on land during its emergence.

Playfair's illustrations of Hutton.—The explanation put forth by Hutton, along with Playfair, who illustrated his theory, regarding the origin of valleys and alluvial deposits, was also quite incomplete. They attributed none of the unevenness of the earth's surface to movements that came with the uplift of the land, believing that valleys were mostly shaped over time by the rivers currently flowing through them; while they seemed not to consider the eroding and transporting power that ocean waves could have on land as it rose.

Although Hutton's knowledge of mineralogy and chemistry was considerable, he possessed but little information concerning organic remains; they merely served him, as they did Werner, to characterize certain strata, and to prove their marine origin. The theory of former revolutions in organic life was not yet fully recognized; and without this class of proofs in support of the antiquity of the globe, the indefinite periods demanded by the Huttonian hypothesis appeared visionary to many; and some, who deemed the doctrine inconsistent with revealed truths, indulged very uncharitable suspicions of the motives of its author. They accused him of a deliberate design of reviving the heathen dogma of an "eternal succession," and of denying that this world ever had a beginning. Playfair, in the biography of his friend, has the following comment on this part of their theory:—"In the planetary motions, where geometry has carried the eye so far, both into the future and the54 past, we discover no mark either of the commencement or termination of the present order. It is unreasonable, indeed, to suppose that such marks should anywhere exist. The Author of Nature has not given laws to the universe, which, like the institutions of men, carry in themselves the elements of their own destruction. He has not permitted in His works any symptom of infancy or of old age, or any sign by which we may estimate either their future or their past duration. He may put an end, as he no doubt gave a beginning, to the present system, at some determinate period of time; but we may rest assured that this great catastrophe will not be brought about by the laws now existing, and that it is not indicated, by any thing which we perceive."107

Although Hutton had a strong understanding of mineralogy and chemistry, he had limited knowledge about organic remains; they only helped him, as they did Werner, to identify certain layers of rock and to show their marine origins. The theory of past revolutions in organic life wasn't fully accepted yet; and without this type of evidence supporting the Earth's age, the long timeframes required by the Huttonian hypothesis seemed unrealistic to many. Some even believed the theory conflicted with revealed truths and entertained uncharitable suspicions about its author's motives. They accused him of intentionally trying to revive the pagan belief in "eternal succession" and of denying that the world ever had a beginning. Playfair, in his biography of Hutton, makes this observation about that part of their theory:—"In planetary motion, where geometry has allowed us to look both forward and backward in time, we find no evidence of either the beginning or the end of the current order. It’s unreasonable to think that such evidence would exist anywhere. The Creator of Nature hasn't established laws for the universe that, like human institutions, contain the seeds of their own destruction. His works show no signs of youth or old age, or any markers that could help us estimate their future or past durations. He may end, just as he surely began, the current system at some specific time; but we can be certain that such a great event will not be caused by the laws that currently exist, and it won't be indicated by anything we observe."107

The party feeling excited against the Huttonian doctrines, and the open disregard of candor and temper in the controversy, will hardly be credited by the reader, unless he recalls to his recollection that the mind of the English public was at that time in a state of feverish excitement. A class of writers in France had been laboring industriously for many years, to diminish the influence of the clergy, by sapping the foundations of the Christian faith; and their success, and the consequences of the Revolution, had alarmed the most resolute minds, while the imagination of the more timid was continually haunted by dread of innovation, as by the phantom of some fearful dream.

The party, fueled by excitement against the Huttonian beliefs and a blatant lack of honesty and restraint in the debate, might be hard for the reader to believe unless they remember that the English public was experiencing a feverish excitement at that time. A group of writers in France had been working hard for many years to weaken the clergy's influence by undermining the foundations of Christian faith. Their success and the fallout from the Revolution had alarmed even the most steadfast thinkers, while the more anxious minds were constantly haunted by the fear of change, like the ghost of a terrifying dream.

Voltaire.—Voltaire had used the modern discoveries in physics as one of the numerous weapons of attack and ridicule directed by him against the Scriptures. He found that the most popular systems of geology were accommodated to the sacred writings, and that much ingenuity had been employed to make every fact coincide exactly with the Mosaic account of the creation and deluge. It was, therefore, with no friendly feelings that he contemplated the cultivators of geology in general, regarding the science as one which had been successfully enlisted by theologians as an ally in their cause.108 He knew that the majority of those who were aware of the abundance of fossil shells in the interior of continents, were still persuaded that they were proofs of the universal deluge; and as the readiest way of shaking this article of faith, he endeavored to inculcate skepticism as to the real nature of such shells, and to recall from contempt the exploded dogma of the sixteenth century, that they were sports of nature. He also pretended that vegetable impressions were not those of real plants.109 Yet he was perfectly convinced that the shells had really belonged to living testacea, as may 55be seen in his essay "On the formation of Mountains."110 He would sometimes, in defiance of all consistency, shift his ground when addressing the vulgar; and, admitting the true nature of the shells collected in the Alps and other places, pretend that they were Eastern species, which had fallen from the hats of pilgrims coming from Syria. The numerous essays written by him on geological subjects were all calculated to strengthen prejudices, partly because he was ignorant of the real state of the science, and partly from his bad faith.111 On the other hand, they who knew that his attacks were directed by a desire to invalidate Scripture, and who were unacquainted with the true merits of the question, might well deem the old diluvian hypothesis incontrovertible, if Voltaire could adduce no better argument against it than to deny the true nature of organic remains.

Voltaire.—Voltaire used modern discoveries in physics as one of the many tools to attack and mock the Scriptures. He noted that the most popular geological theories were adjusted to fit the sacred texts, and that a lot of creativity had been used to align every fact with the Biblical accounts of creation and the flood. Therefore, he did not hold a favorable view of geologists in general, seeing the science as one that had been successfully recruited by theologians as a supporter of their beliefs.108 He recognized that most people aware of the abundance of fossil shells found in the interiors of continents still believed they were evidence of a global flood; and to challenge this belief, he tried to promote skepticism about the true nature of these shells and to revive the debunked idea from the sixteenth century that they were just natural oddities. He also claimed that plant impressions weren't from actual plants.109 Yet he was fully convinced that the shells had actually come from living mollusks, as seen in his essay "On the Formation of Mountains."110 Sometimes, in contradiction to his own views, he would change his stance when speaking to the general public, and, acknowledging the true nature of the shells found in the Alps and elsewhere, he would suggest they were Eastern varieties that had fallen off the hats of pilgrims returning from Syria. His many essays on geological topics were aimed at reinforcing biases, partly because he was unaware of the real state of the science and partly due to his dishonesty.111 On the other hand, those who understood that his criticisms were motivated by a desire to undermine Scripture, and who were unaware of the true merits of the debate, might have considered the old flood theory indisputable if Voltaire could provide no better argument against it than simply denying the true nature of organic remains.

It is only by careful attention to impediments originating in extrinsic causes, that we can explain the slow and reluctant adoption of the simplest truths in geology. First, we find many able naturalists adducing the fossil remains of marine animals as proofs of an event related in Scripture. The evidence is deemed conclusive by the multitude for a century or more; for it favors opinions which they entertained before, and they are gratified by supposing them confirmed by fresh and unexpected proofs. Many who see through the fallacy have no wish to undeceive those who are influenced by it, approving the effect of the delusion, and conniving at it as a pious fraud; until, finally, an opposite party, who are hostile to the sacred writings, labor to explode the erroneous opinion, by substituting for it another dogma, which they know to be equally unsound.

It is only by paying close attention to obstacles that come from outside factors that we can understand the gradual and reluctant acceptance of even the simplest truths in geology. First, we notice many skilled naturalists pointing to fossil remains of marine animals as evidence of an event described in the Bible. For over a century, the majority accepts this evidence as conclusive; it supports opinions that they already held, and they are pleased to think these views have been reinforced by new and unexpected proof. Many who recognize the fallacy have no desire to correct those misled by it, approving of the delusion's effects, and tolerating it as a noble deception; until eventually, an opposing group, which is against the sacred texts, works to dismantle the false belief by replacing it with another doctrine that they know is equally flawed.

The heretical Vulcanists were soon after openly assailed in England, by imputations of the most illiberal kind. We cannot estimate the malevolence of such a persecution, by the pain which similar insinuations might now inflict; for although charges of infidelity and atheism must always be odious, they were injurious in the extreme at that moment of political excitement; and it was better, perhaps, for a man's good reception in society, that his moral character should have been traduced, than that he should become a mark for these poisoned weapons.

The radical Vulcanists were soon openly attacked in England, facing accusations that were incredibly narrow-minded. We can't really measure the cruelty of such persecution by the hurt that similar suggestions might cause today; although claims of disloyalty and atheism will always be offensive, they were especially damaging during that time of political turmoil. It might have been better for someone's standing in society if their moral character was slandered than if they became a target for these harmful attacks.

I shall pass over the works of numerous divines, who may be excused for sensitiveness on points which then excited so much uneasiness in the public mind; and shall say nothing of the amiable poet Cowper,112 who 56could hardly be expected to have inquired into the merit of doctrines in physics. But in the foremost ranks of the intolerant are found several laymen who had high claims to scientific reputation. Among these appears Williams, a mineral surveyor of Edinburgh, who published a "Natural History of the Mineral Kingdom," in 1789; a work of great merit, for that day, and of practical utility, as containing the best account of the coal strata. In his preface he misrepresents Hutton's theory altogether, and charges him with considering all rocks to be lavas of different colors and structure; and also with "warping every thing to support the eternity of the world."113 He descants on the pernicious influence of such skeptical notions, as leading to downright infidelity and atheism, "and as being nothing less than to depose the Almighty Creator of the universe from his office."114

I will skip over the works of many religious scholars, who can be excused for their sensitivity on issues that stirred a lot of anxiety in the public at that time; and I won’t mention the kind poet Cowper,112 who 56could hardly be expected to analyze the value of theories in physics. However, at the forefront of the intolerant are several laypeople who had strong claims to scientific credibility. Among these is Williams, a mineral surveyor from Edinburgh, who published a "Natural History of the Mineral Kingdom" in 1789; a work that was quite impressive for its time and of practical use, as it provided the best description of the coal strata. In his preface, he completely misrepresents Hutton's theory and accuses him of believing that all rocks are lavas of different colors and structures; he also claims Hutton is "warping everything to support the eternity of the world."113 He goes on about the harmful effects of such skeptical ideas, saying they lead to outright infidelity and atheism, "and are nothing less than an attempt to remove the Almighty Creator of the universe from his position."114

KirwanDe Luc.—Kirwan, president of the Royal Academy of Dublin, a chemist and mineralogist of some merit, but who possessed much greater authority in the scientific world than he was entitled by his talents to enjoy, said, in the introduction to his "Geological Essays, 1799," "that sound geology graduated into religion, and was required to dispel certain systems of atheism or infidelity, of which they had had recent experience."115 He was an uncompromising defender of the aqueous theory of all rocks, and was scarcely surpassed by Burnet and Whiston, in his desire to adduce the Mosaic writings in confirmation of his opinions.

KirwanDe Luc.—Kirwan, president of the Royal Academy of Dublin, was a chemist and mineralogist with some merit, though he had more authority in the scientific community than his talents warranted. In the introduction to his "Geological Essays, 1799," he stated that sound geology graduated into religion and was necessary to counter certain systems of atheism or infidelity, which they had recently encountered.115 He was a staunch supporter of the aqueous theory for all rocks and was hardly surpassed by Burnet and Whiston in his eagerness to use the Mosaic writings to support his views.

De Luc, in the preliminary discourse to his Treatise on Geology,116 says, "The weapons have been changed by which revealed religion is attacked; it is now assailed by geology, and the knowledge of this science has become essential to theologians." He imputes the failure of former geological systems to their having been anti-Mosaical, and directed against a "sublime tradition." These and similar imputations, reiterated in the works of De Luc, seem to have been taken for granted by some modern writers: it is therefore necessary to state, in justice to the numerous geologists of different nations, whose works have been considered, that none of them were guilty of endeavoring, by arguments drawn from physics, to invalidate scriptural tenets. On the contrary, the majority of those who were fortunate enough "to discover the true causes of things," rarely deserved another part of the poet's panegyric, "Atque metus omnes subjecit pedibus." The caution and even timid reserve, of many eminent Italian authors of the earlier period is very apparent; and there can hardly be a doubt, that they subscribed to certain dogmas, and particularly to the first diluvian theory, out of deference to popular prejudices, rather than from conviction. If they were guilty of dissimulation, we may feel regret, but must not blame their want of moral courage, reserving rather our condemnation for the intol57erance of the times, and that inquisitorial power which forced Galileo to abjure, and the two Jesuits to disclaim the theory of Newton.117

De Luc, in the introductory discussion of his **Treatise on Geology**,116 states, "The approaches used to challenge revealed religion have changed; it is now attacked by geology, and understanding this science has become crucial for theologians." He blames the failure of past geological theories on their being anti-Mosaic and aimed at a "sublime tradition." These and similar accusations, repeated in De Luc's works, seem to have been accepted by some modern writers. It is therefore important to clarify, in fairness to the many geologists from various countries whose works have been reviewed, that none of them attempted to undermine scriptural beliefs using arguments based on physics. In fact, most of those who were fortunate enough "to discover the true causes of things," rarely lived up to another part of the poet's praise, "Atque metus omnes subjecit pedibus." The caution and even hesitance of many distinguished Italian authors from earlier times is quite clear; there is little doubt that they adhered to certain doctrines, especially the initial flood theory, out of respect for public opinion rather than genuine belief. If they were guilty of hiding their true thoughts, we may feel regret, but we should not blame their lack of moral courage, instead directing our criticism towards the intolerance of the era, and the inquisitorial power that forced Galileo to recant, and the two Jesuits to renounce Newton’s theory.117

Hutton answered Kirwan's attacks with great warmth, and with the indignation justly excited by unmerited reproach. "He had always displayed," says Playfair, "the utmost disposition to admire the beneficent design manifested in the structure of the world; and he contemplated with delight those parts of his theory which made the greatest additions to our knowledge of final causes." We may say with equal truth, that in no scientific works in our language can more eloquent passages be found, concerning the fitness, harmony, and grandeur of all parts of the creation, than in those of Playfair. They are evidently the unaffected expressions of a mind, which contemplated the study of nature, as best calculated to elevate our conceptions of the attributes of the First Cause. At any other time the force and elegance of Playfair's style must have insured popularity to the Huttonian doctrines; but by a singular coincidence, Neptunianism and orthodoxy were now associated in the same creed; and the tide of prejudice ran so strong, that the majority were carried far away into the chaotic fluid, and other cosmological inventions of Werner. These fictions the Saxon professor had borrowed with little modification, and without any improvement, from his predecessors. They had not the smallest foundation either in Scripture or in common sense, and were probably approved of by many as being so ideal and unsubstantial, that they could never come into violent collision with any preconceived opinions.

Hutton responded to Kirwan's criticisms with genuine warmth and justified anger at unfair blame. "He had always shown," says Playfair, "the greatest willingness to admire the helpful design evident in the structure of the world; and he took pleasure in those parts of his theory that contributed the most to our understanding of ultimate purposes." We can equally assert that no scientific writings in our language contain more powerful passages about the suitability, harmony, and magnificence of all aspects of creation than those by Playfair. They clearly reflect the sincere thoughts of a mind that saw the study of nature as the best way to enhance our understanding of the attributes of the First Cause. At any other time, the strength and grace of Playfair's writing would have made the Huttonian ideas popular; however, due to a strange coincidence, Neptunianism and orthodoxy were now linked within the same belief system, and the wave of bias was so strong that most people were swept far into the chaotic fluid and other cosmological theories of Werner. These fantasies were borrowed by the Saxon professor with little alteration and no enhancement from his predecessors. They had no real basis in Scripture or common sense and were likely accepted by many as being so theoretical and insubstantial that they would never conflict with any existing beliefs.

According to De Luc, the first essential distinction to be made between the various phenomena exhibited on the surface of the earth was, to determine which were the results of causes still in action, and which had been produced by causes that had ceased to act. The form and composition of the mass of our continents, he said, and their existence above the level of the sea, must be ascribed to causes no longer in action. These continents emerged, at no very remote period, on the sudden retreat of the ocean, the waters of which made their way into subterranean caverns. The formation of the rocks which enter into the crust of the earth began with the precipitation of granite from a primordial liquid, after which other strata containing the remains of or58ganized bodies were deposited, till at last the present sea remained as the residuum of the primordial liquid, and no longer continued to produce mineral strata.118

According to De Luc, the first key distinction to make between the different phenomena seen on the earth's surface was to identify which were caused by ongoing processes and which were the result of processes that had stopped. He stated that the shape and makeup of our continents, along with their position above sea level, could be attributed to causes that are no longer active. These continents appeared not too long ago when the ocean suddenly receded, allowing water to flow into underground caves. The formation of the rocks in the earth's crust started with granite precipitating from a primordial liquid, followed by the deposition of other layers containing the remains of organized bodies, until eventually what we know as the present sea remained as a residue of the primordial liquid, which no longer continued to create mineral layers.118

William Smith, 1790.—While the tenets of the rival schools of Freyberg and Edinburgh were warmly espoused by devoted partisans, the labors of an individual, unassisted by the advantages of wealth or station in society, were almost unheeded. Mr. William Smith, an English surveyor, published his "Tabular View of the British Strata" in 1790, wherein he proposed a classification of the secondary formations in the West of England. Although he had not communicated with Werner, it appeared by this work that he had arrived at the same views respecting the laws of superposition of stratified rocks; that he was aware that the order of succession of different groups was never inverted; and that they might be identified at very distant points by their peculiar organized fossils.

William Smith, 1790.—While the beliefs of the competing schools of Freyberg and Edinburgh were passionately supported by loyal followers, the efforts of one individual, lacking the perks of wealth or social status, went largely unnoticed. Mr. William Smith, an English surveyor, published his "Tabular View of the British Strata" in 1790, in which he proposed a way to classify the secondary formations in the West of England. Even though he hadn't communicated with Werner, it was clear from his work that he had reached similar conclusions about the principles of stratified rock layering; he recognized that the sequence of different groups was never reversed, and that they could be identified at very distant locations by their unique fossilized remains.

From the time of the appearance of the "Tabular View," the author labored to construct a geological map of the whole of England; and with the greatest disinterestedness of mind, communicated the results of his investigations to all who desired information, giving such publicity to his original views, as to enable his contemporaries almost to compete with him in the race. The execution of his map was completed in 1815, and remains a lasting monument of original talent and extraordinary perseverance; for he had explored the whole country on foot, without the guidance of previous observers, or the aid of fellow-laborers, and had succeeded in throwing into natural divisions the whole complicated series of British rocks. D'Aubuisson, a distinguished pupil of Werner, paid a just tribute of praise to this remarkable performance, observing, that "what many celebrated mineralogists had only accomplished for a small part of Germany in the course of half a century, had been effected by a single individual for the whole of England."119

Since the release of the "Tabular View," the author worked hard to create a geological map of all of England. With great selflessness, he shared the results of his research with anyone who wanted to know, making his original ideas public so that his contemporaries could nearly compete with him in the field. He finished his map in 1815, which stands as a lasting testament to his originality and incredible perseverance; he traveled across the entire country on foot, without the help of previous researchers or collaborators, and managed to organize the entire complex array of British rocks into natural groupings. D'Aubuisson, a notable student of Werner, justly praised this impressive achievement, noting that "what many famous mineralogists had taken half a century to accomplish for a small part of Germany, one individual achieved for the entire country of England."119

Werner invented a new language to express his divisions of rocks, and some of his technical terms, such as grauwacke, gneiss, and others, passed current in every country in Europe. Smith adopted for the most part English provincial terms, often of barbarous sound, such as gault, cornbrash, clunch clay; and affixed them to subdivisions of the British series. Many of these still retain their place in our scientific classifications, and attest his priority of arrangement.

Werner created a new language to categorize rocks, and some of his technical terms, like grauwacke and gneiss, became widely used across Europe. Smith mostly chose English regional terms, often harsh-sounding, such as gault, cornbrash, and clunch clay, and used them for the subdivisions of the British series. Many of these terms are still part of our scientific classifications today and demonstrate his original system of organization.

MODERN PROGRESS OF GEOLOGY.

Modern Advances in Geology.

The contention of the rival factions of the Vulcanists and Neptunists had been carried to such a height, that these names had become terms of reproach; and the two parties had been less occupied in searching for truth, than for such arguments as might strengthen their own cause or serve to annoy their antagonists. A new school at last arose, who 59professed the strictest neutrality, and the utmost indifference to the systems of Werner and Hutton, and who resolved diligently to devote their labors to observation. The reaction, provoked by the intemperance of the conflicting parties, now produced a tendency to extreme caution. Speculative views were discountenanced, and, through fear of exposing themselves to the suspicion of a bias towards the dogmas of a party, some geologists became anxious to entertain no opinion whatever on the causes of phenomena, and were inclined to skepticism even where the conclusions deducible from observed facts scarcely admitted of reasonable doubt.

The rivalry between the Vulcanists and Neptunists escalated to the point where these names became insults. Both sides focused more on finding arguments to support their cause or annoy their opponents than on searching for the truth. Eventually, a new group emerged that 59claimed strict neutrality and complete indifference to the theories of Werner and Hutton, deciding to dedicate their efforts to observation. The backlash from the heated disputes led to a strong tendency for caution. Speculative ideas were discouraged, and out of fear of being seen as biased toward a particular ideology, some geologists became hesitant to express any opinions about the causes of phenomena and leaned toward skepticism, even when the conclusions drawn from observed facts were almost certain.

Geological Society of London.—But although the reluctance to theorize was carried somewhat to excess, no measure could be more salutary at such a moment than a suspension of all attempts to form what were termed "theories of the earth." A great body of new data were required; and the Geological Society of London, founded in 1807, conduced greatly to the attainment of this desirable end. To multiply and record observations, and patiently to await the result at some future period, was the object proposed by them; and it was their favorite maxim that the time was not yet come for a general system of geology, but that all must be content for many years to be exclusively engaged in furnishing materials for future generalizations. By acting up to these principles with consistency, they in a few years disarmed all prejudice, and rescued the science from the imputation of being a dangerous, or at best but a visionary pursuit.

Geological Society of London.—Even though the hesitation to theorize was taken a bit too far, nothing could be more beneficial at that time than pausing all efforts to establish what were called "theories of the earth." A lot of new data was needed; and the Geological Society of London, founded in 1807, greatly contributed to achieving this important goal. Their aim was to increase and document observations while patiently waiting for results to emerge in the future. They held the belief that the time for a comprehensive system of geology had not yet arrived, and that everyone needed to focus for many years solely on providing materials for future generalizations. By consistently adhering to these principles, they soon overcame any bias and saved the science from being seen as a dangerous or, at best, merely fanciful endeavor.

A distinguished modern writer has with truth remarked, that the advancement of three of the main divisions of geological inquiry have during the last half century been promoted successively by three different nations of Europe,—the Germans, the English, and the French.120 We have seen that the systematic study of what may be called mineralogical geology had its origin and chief point of activity in Germany, where Werner first described with precision the mineral characters of rocks. The classification of the secondary formations, each marked by their peculiar fossils, belongs, in a great measure, to England, where the labors before alluded to of Smith, and those of the most active members of the Geological Society of London, were steadily directed to these objects. The foundation of the third branch, that relating to the tertiary formations, was laid in France by the splendid work of Cuvier and Brongniart, published in 1808, "On the Mineral Geography and Organic Remains of the Neighborhood of Paris."

A well-known modern writer has rightly pointed out that the progress in three major areas of geological research over the last fifty years has been driven by three different European nations—the Germans, the English, and the French.120 We can see that the systematic study of what can be called mineralogical geology began and thrived in Germany, where Werner first accurately described the mineral characteristics of rocks. The classification of secondary formations, each identified by their unique fossils, is largely attributed to England, where the earlier efforts of Smith and those of the most active members of the Geological Society of London were consistently focused on these goals. The foundation of the third area, dealing with tertiary formations, was established in France through the remarkable work of Cuvier and Brongniart, published in 1808, "On the Mineral Geography and Organic Remains of the Neighborhood of Paris."

We may still trace, in the language of the science and our present methods of arrangement, the various countries where the growth of these several departments of geology was at different times promoted. Many names of simple minerals and rocks remain to this day German; while the European divisions of the secondary strata are in great part English, and are, indeed, often founded too exclusively on English types. Lastly, the subdivisions first established of the succession of strata in the Paris 60basin have served as normal groups to which other tertiary deposits throughout Europe have been compared, even in cases where this standard was wholly inapplicable.

We can still see, in the terms of the science and our current ways of organizing information, the various countries that have contributed to the development of different areas of geology over time. Many names for simple minerals and rocks are still German; meanwhile, the European divisions of the secondary layers are mostly English and are often based too heavily on English examples. Lastly, the initial divisions established for the sequence of layers in the Paris 60 basin have served as standard groups that other tertiary deposits across Europe have been compared to, even in situations where this benchmark was completely irrelevant.

No period could have been more fortunate for the discovery, in the immediate neighborhood of Paris, of a rich store of well-preserved fossils, than the commencement of the present century; for at no former era had Natural history been cultivated with such enthusiasm in the French metropolis. The labors of Cuvier in comparative osteology, and of Lamarck in recent and fossil shells, had raised these departments of study to a rank of which they had never previously been deemed susceptible. Their investigations had eventually a powerful effect in dispelling the illusion which had long prevailed concerning the absence of analogy between the ancient and modern state of our planet. A close comparison of the recent and fossil species and the inferences drawn in regard to their habits, accustomed the geologist to contemplate the earth as having been at successive periods the dwelling-place of animals and plants of different races, some terrestrial, and others aquatic—some fitted to live in seas, others in the waters of lakes and rivers. By the consideration of these topics, the mind was slowly and insensibly withdrawn from imaginary pictures of catastrophes and chaotic confusion, such as haunted the imagination of the early cosmogonists. Numerous proofs were discovered of the tranquil deposition of sedimentary matter, and the slow development of organic life. If many writers, and Cuvier himself in the number, still continued to maintain, that "the thread of induction was broken,"121 yet, in reasoning by the strict rules of induction from recent to fossil species, they in a great measure disclaimed the dogma which in theory they professed. The adoption of the same generic, and, in some cases, even of the same specific, names for the exuviæ of fossil animals and their living analogues, was an important step towards familiarizing the mind with the idea of the identity and unity of the system in distant eras. It was an acknowledgment, as it were, that part at least of the ancient memorials of nature were written in a living language. The growing importance, then, of the natural history of organic remains may be pointed out as the characteristic feature of the progress of the science during the present century. This branch of knowledge has already become an instrument of great utility in geological classification, and is continuing daily to unfold new data for grand and enlarged views respecting the former changes of the earth.

No time could have been more fortunate for discovering a treasure of well-preserved fossils near Paris than the start of this century, as Natural history had never been so passionately studied in the French capital before. The work of Cuvier in comparative osteology and Lamarck in recent and fossil shells had elevated these fields of study to a level never seen before. Their research had a powerful impact in dispelling the long-held belief that there was no connection between the ancient and modern states of our planet. A detailed comparison of recent and fossil species, along with the insights gained about their behaviors, allowed geologists to see the Earth as a place that hosted different animals and plants throughout various periods—some land-dwelling and others aquatic, some suited for the sea and others for lakes and rivers. By considering these subjects, people's minds were slowly and subtly pulled away from imagined disasters and chaotic confusion that had preoccupied early thinkers about the universe's origins. Many pieces of evidence were found showing the calm deposition of sedimentary materials and the gradual development of living organisms. Although many writers, including Cuvier, continued to argue that "the thread of induction was broken,"121 when reasoning inductively from recent to fossil species, they largely rejected the theory they claimed to uphold. The use of the same generic and sometimes even specific names for the remains of fossil animals and their living counterparts was a crucial step in helping people understand the idea of identity and continuity in different eras. It was as if it acknowledged that at least part of the ancient records of nature were written in a living language. Therefore, the increasing importance of the natural history of organic remains can be seen as a defining feature of the progress of science in this century. This area of knowledge has already become a valuable tool in geological classification and continues to reveal new information for broader and deeper insights into the Earth's past changes.

When we compare the result of observations in the last fifty years with those of the three preceding centuries, we cannot but look forward with the most sanguine expectations to the degree of excellence to which geology may be carried, even by the labors of the present generation. Never, perhaps, did any science, with the exception of astronomy, unfold, in an equally brief period, so many novel and unexpected truths, and overturn so many preconceived opinions. The senses had for ages declared the earth to be at rest, until the astronomer taught that it was 61carried through space with inconceivable rapidity. In like manner was the surface of this planet regarded as having remained unaltered since its creation, until the geologist proved that it had been the theatre of reiterated change, and was still the subject of slow but never-ending fluctuations. The discovery of other systems in the boundless regions of space was the triumph of astronomy; to trace the same system through various transformations—to behold it at successive eras adorned with different hills and valleys, lakes and seas, and peopled with new inhabitants, was the delightful meed of geological research. By the geometer were measured the regions of space, and the relative distances of the heavenly bodies;—by the geologist myriads of ages were reckoned, not by arithmetical computation, but by a train of physical events—a succession of phenomena in the animate and inanimate worlds—signs which convey to our minds more definite ideas than figures can do of the immensity of time.

When we compare the observations from the last fifty years to those from the three centuries before that, we can't help but look forward with the most optimistic expectations for how far geology might advance, thanks to the efforts of today's generation. Perhaps no science, except for astronomy, has revealed so many new and surprising truths in such a short time, or challenged so many established beliefs. For ages, our senses led us to believe that the earth was still, until astronomers showed us that it moves through space at unimaginable speeds. Similarly, the surface of our planet was thought to have remained unchanged since its creation, until geologists demonstrated that it has undergone repeated changes and continues to experience slow but constant fluctuations. The discovery of other systems in the vast expanse of space was astronomy's triumph; tracing the same system through various transformations—seeing it at different times with diverse hills and valleys, lakes and seas, and populated by new life—was the rewarding result of geological study. The geometer measured the regions of space and the distances between celestial bodies; the geologist, on the other hand, counted countless ages, not through arithmetic, but by a series of physical events—a sequence of phenomena in both living and non-living worlds—signals that convey more precise ideas about the vastness of time than numbers ever could.

Whether our investigation of the earth's history and structure will eventually be productive of as great practical benefits to mankind as a knowledge of the distant heavens, must remain for the decision of posterity. It was not till astronomy had been enriched by the observations of many centuries, and had made its way against popular prejudices to the establishment of a sound theory, that its application to the useful arts was most conspicuous. The cultivation of geology began at a later period; and in every step which it has hitherto made towards sound theoretical principles, it had to contend against more violent prepossessions. The practical advantages already derived from it have not been inconsiderable; but our generalizations are yet imperfect, and they who come after us may be expected to reap the most valuable fruits of our labor. Meanwhile, the charm of first discovery is our own; and, as we explore this magnificent field of inquiry, the sentiment of a great historian of our times may continually be present to our minds, that "he who calls what has vanished back again into being, enjoys a bliss like that of creating."122

Whether our investigation of the earth's history and structure will eventually benefit humanity as much as our understanding of the distant heavens is something that will be determined by future generations. It wasn't until astronomy was enhanced by centuries of observation and overcame widespread biases to establish a solid theory that its use in practical fields became most apparent. The development of geology started later, and each advancement it has made towards solid theoretical principles has faced even stronger biases. The practical benefits we've already gained from it have been significant, but our theories are still incomplete, and those who follow us will likely enjoy the most valuable results of our efforts. In the meantime, the excitement of new discovery is ours; as we delve into this amazing area of study, we might often recall the words of a great historian of our era: "he who brings what has disappeared back into existence experiences a joy similar to that of creating."122


CHAPTER V

PREJUDICES WHICH HAVE RETARDED THE PROGRESS OF GEOLOGY

Prepossessions in regard to the duration of past time—Prejudices arising from our peculiar position as inhabitants of the land—Of those occasioned by our not seeing subterranean changes now in progress—All these causes combine to make the former course of Nature appear different from the present—Objections to the doctrine, that causes similar in kind and energy to those now acting, have produced the former changes of the earth's surface, considered.

Preconceptions about how long the past has lasted—Biases stemming from our unique perspective as residents of this land—And those created by our inability to observe the underground changes currently happening—All these factors come together to make the earlier state of Nature seem different from how it is now—Concerns about the idea that causes similar in type and strength to those acting today have led to the past changes of the earth's surface are discussed.

If we reflect on the history of the progress of geology, as explained in the preceding chapters, we perceive that there have been great fluctuations 62 of opinion respecting the nature of the causes to which all former changes of the earth's surface are referable. The first observers conceived the monuments which the geologist endeavors to decipher to relate to an original state of the earth, or to a period when there were causes in activity, distinct, in kind and degree, from those now constituting the economy of nature. These views were gradually modified, and some of them entirely abandoned, in proportion as observations were multiplied, and the signs of former mutations more skilfully interpreted. Many appearances, which had for a long time been regarded as indicating mysterious and extraordinary agency, were finally recognized as the necessary result of the laws now governing the material world; and the discovery of this unlooked-for conformity has at length induced some philosophers to infer, that, during the ages contemplated in geology, there has never been any interruption to the agency of the same uniform laws of change. The same assemblage of general causes, they conceive, may have been sufficient to produce, by their various combinations, the endless diversity of effects, of which the shell of the earth has preserved the memorials; and, consistently with these principles, the recurrence of analogous changes is expected by them in time to come.

If we think about the history of geology's progress, as discussed in the earlier chapters, we can see that there have been significant shifts in opinions regarding the causes behind all past changes to the earth's surface. The first observers believed that the remains the geologist tries to understand were related to an original state of the earth or a time when different causes were at work compared to those that currently shape nature. These ideas were gradually adjusted, and some were completely abandoned, as more observations were made and the signs of past changes were more skillfully interpreted. Many phenomena that had long been seen as signs of mysterious and extraordinary forces were eventually understood as the necessary results of the laws currently governing the material world. This surprising alignment has led some philosophers to conclude that throughout the ages studied in geology, there has never been a break in the influence of the same consistent laws of change. They believe that the same group of general causes may have been adequate to produce, through various combinations, the endless variety of effects that the earth's shell has preserved evidence of; and, based on these principles, they anticipate the recurrence of similar changes in the future.

Whether we coincide or not in this doctrine, we must admit that the gradual progress of opinion concerning the succession of phenomena in very remote eras, resembles, in a singular manner, that which has accompanied the growing intelligence of every people, in regard to the economy of nature in their own times. In an early state of advancement, when a great number of natural appearances are unintelligible, an eclipse, an earthquake, a flood, or the approach of a comet, with many other occurrences afterwards found to belong to the regular course of events, are regarded as prodigies. The same delusion prevails as to moral phenomena, and many of these are ascribed to the intervention of demons, ghosts, witches, and other immaterial and supernatural agents. By degrees, many of the enigmas of the moral and physical world are explained, and, instead of being due to extrinsic and irregular causes, they are found to depend on fixed and invariable laws. The philosopher at last becomes convinced of the undeviating uniformity of secondary causes; and, guided by his faith in this principle, he determines the probability of accounts transmitted to him of former occurrences, and often rejects the fabulous tales of former times, on the ground of their being irreconcilable with the experience of more enlightened ages.

Whether we agree or not on this principle, we have to recognize that the gradual evolution of thought regarding the sequence of events in very distant times resembles, in a remarkable way, the rising understanding of every society about the workings of nature in their own periods. In the early stages of development, when many natural phenomena are baffling, an eclipse, an earthquake, a flood, or the arrival of a comet, along with several other events later understood to be part of regular occurrences, are seen as wonders. The same misunderstanding applies to moral events, many of which are attributed to the actions of demons, ghosts, witches, and other immaterial and supernatural beings. Over time, many of the mysteries of the moral and physical world are clarified, and instead of being caused by external and irregular factors, they are revealed to depend on fixed and unchanging laws. The philosopher eventually becomes convinced of the consistent nature of secondary causes; and, guided by his belief in this principle, he assesses the credibility of accounts handed down to him of past events, often dismissing the fanciful stories of the past as incompatible with the experiences of more enlightened times.

Prepossessions in regard to the duration of past time.—As a belief in the want of conformity in the causes by which the earth's crust has been modified in ancient and modern periods was, for a long time, universally prevalent, and that, too, amongst men who were convinced that the order of nature had been uniform for the last several thousand years, every circumstance which could have influenced their minds and given an undue bias to their opinions deserves particular attention.63 Now the reader may easily satisfy himself, that, however undeviating the course of nature may have been from the earliest epochs, it was impossible for the first cultivators of geology to come to such a conclusion, so long as they were under a delusion as to the age of the world, and the date of the first creation of animate beings. However fantastical some theories of the sixteenth century may now appear to us,—however unworthy of men of great talent and sound judgment,—we may rest assured that, if the same misconception now prevailed in regard to the memorials of human transactions, it would give rise to a similar train of absurdities. Let us imagine, for example, that Champollion, and the French and Tuscan literati lately engaged in exploring the antiquities of Egypt, had visited that country with a firm belief that the banks of the Nile were never peopled by the human race before the beginning of the nineteenth century, and that their faith in this dogma was as difficult to shake as the opinion of our ancestors that the earth was never the abode of living beings until the creation of the present continents, and of the species now existing,—it is easy to perceive what extravagant systems they would frame, while under the influence of this delusion, to account for the monuments discovered in Egypt. The sight of the pyramids, obelisks, colossal statues, and ruined temples, would fill them with such astonishment, that for a time they would be as men spell-bound—wholly incapable of reasoning with sobriety. They might incline at first to refer the construction of such stupendous works to some superhuman powers of a primeval world. A system might be invented resembling that so gravely advanced by Manetho, who relates that a dynasty of gods originally ruled in Egypt, of whom Vulcan, the first monarch, reigned nine thousand years; after whom came Hercules and other demigods, who were at last succeeded by human kings.

Prepossessions regarding the duration of past time.—For a long time, there was a widespread belief that the processes that shaped the earth's crust in ancient and modern times were not consistent, even among people who believed that the natural order had been stable for thousands of years. Every factor that could have influenced their thinking and biased their opinions deserves close examination.63 Now, the reader can easily realize that, no matter how consistent nature may have been from the earliest times, it was impossible for the early pioneers of geology to reach such conclusions while they were under the mistaken impression about the age of the world and when living beings first appeared. Some theories from the sixteenth century might seem ridiculous to us now—no matter how unworthy they were of highly talented and rational individuals—but we can be sure that if the same misunderstandings existed today regarding historical events, they would lead to similarly absurd ideas. For instance, imagine if Champollion and the French and Tuscan scholars recently studying Egypt's antiquities believed that the banks of the Nile had never been inhabited by humans before the early nineteenth century, and that their faith in this idea was as unshakable as our ancestors' belief that the earth was lifeless until the continents and species we know today were created. It’s easy to see what outrageous theories they would come up with to explain the monuments found in Egypt under the influence of this misconception. The sight of the pyramids, obelisks, colossal statues, and ruined temples would leave them so astonished that they would be like people under a spell—completely unable to think rationally. Initially, they might attribute the construction of such monumental works to some superhuman forces from a primordial world. They could develop a theory similar to the one proposed by Manetho, who recounts that a dynasty of gods first ruled Egypt, with Vulcan as the first king, reigning for nine thousand years, followed by Hercules and other demigods, who were eventually succeeded by human rulers.

When some fanciful speculations of this kind had amused their imaginations for a time, some vast repository of mummies would be discovered, and would immediately undeceive those antiquaries who enjoyed an opportunity of personally examining them; but the prejudices of others at a distance, who were not eye-witnesses of the whole phenomena, would not be so easily overcome. The concurrent report of many travellers would, indeed, render it necessary for them to accommodate ancient theories to some of the new facts, and much wit and ingenuity would be required to modify and defend their old positions. Each new invention would violate a greater number of known analogies; for if a theory be required to embrace some false principle, it becomes more visionary in proportion as facts are multiplied, as would be the case if geometers were now required to form an astronomical system on the assumption of the immobility of the earth.

When some imaginative speculations like this had entertained their minds for a while, a huge cache of mummies would be found, quickly dispelling the notions of those scholars who had the chance to examine them personally. However, the biases of others far away, who had not witnessed the entire situation, would not be so easily swayed. The collective accounts of many travelers would indeed make it necessary for them to adjust ancient theories to fit some of the new facts, requiring a lot of wit and creativity to modify and defend their old views. Each new discovery would contradict more known similarities; because if a theory needs to include some false principle, it becomes more unrealistic as more facts emerge, just like if mathematicians were now expected to build an astronomical system based on the idea that the earth is stationary.

Amongst other fanciful conjectures concerning the history of Egypt, we may suppose some of the following to be started. "As the banks of the Nile have been so recently colonized for the first time, the curious substances called mummies could never in reality have belonged to64 men. They may have been generated by some plastic virtue residing in the interior of the earth, or they may be abortions of Nature produced by her incipient efforts in the work of creation. For if deformed beings are sometimes born even now, when the scheme of the universe is fully developed, many more may have been 'sent before their time, scarce half made up,' when the planet itself was in the embryo state. But if these notions appear to derogate from the perfection of the Divine attributes, and if these mummies be in all their parts true representations of the human form, may we not refer them to the future rather than the past?—May we not be looking into the womb of Nature, and not her grave? May not these images be like the shades of the unborn in Virgil's Elysium—the archetypes of men not yet called into existence?"

Among other fanciful ideas about the history of Egypt, we might consider some of the following suggestions. "Since the banks of the Nile have only recently been colonized for the first time, the strange substances known as mummies could never have actually belonged to64 humans. They might have been created by some plastic virtue found deep within the earth, or they could be the products of Nature's early attempts at creation. If even now, when the universe is fully formed, deformed beings can occasionally be born, then many more might have been 'sent before their time, barely half made,' when the planet itself was still in its early stages. However, if these ideas seem to undermine the perfection of the Divine attributes, and if these mummies are accurate representations of the human form in all their parts, can we not attribute them to the future rather than the past?—Could we be looking into the womb of Nature rather than her grave? Might these images be similar to the shades of the unborn in Virgil's Elysium—the prototypes of humans yet to be brought into existence?"

These speculations, if advocated by eloquent writers, would not fail to attract many zealous votaries, for they would relieve men from the painful necessity of renouncing preconceived opinions. Incredible as such skepticism may appear, it has been rivalled by many systems of the sixteenth and seventeenth centuries, and among others by that of the learned Falloppio, who regarded the tusks of fossil elephants as earthy concretions, and the pottery or fragments of vases in the Monte Testaceo, near Rome, as works of nature, and not of art. But when one generation had passed away, and another, not compromised to the support of antiquated dogmas, had succeeded, they would review the evidence afforded by mummies more impartially, and would no longer controvert the preliminary question, that human beings had lived in Egypt before the nineteenth century: so that when a hundred years perhaps had been lost, the industry and talents of the philosopher would be at last directed to the elucidation of points of real historical importance.

These speculations, if supported by persuasive writers, would definitely attract many enthusiastic followers because they would free people from the uncomfortable need to give up their preconceived beliefs. As unbelievable as this skepticism may seem, it has been matched by many theories from the sixteenth and seventeenth centuries, including that of the learned Falloppio, who viewed the tusks of fossil elephants as natural formations and the pottery or fragments of vases found in Monte Testaceo, near Rome, as natural objects rather than man-made art. However, when one generation passed and another, unbound by outdated doctrines, took its place, they would assess the evidence provided by mummies more fairly and would no longer dispute the basic question of whether human beings lived in Egypt before the nineteenth century. Consequently, after perhaps a hundred years of being lost, the efforts and skills of philosophers would finally be focused on clarifying issues of genuine historical significance.

But the above arguments are aimed against one only of many prejudices with which the earlier geologists had to contend. Even when they conceded that the earth had been peopled with animate beings at an earlier period than was at first supposed, they had no conception that the quantity of time bore so great a proportion to the historical era as is now generally conceded. How fatal every error as to the quantity of time must prove to the introduction of rational views concerning the state of things in former ages, may be conceived by supposing the annals of the civil and military transactions of a great nation to be perused under the impression that they occurred in a period of one hundred instead of two thousand years. Such a portion of history would immediately assume the air of a romance; the events would seem devoid of credibility, and inconsistent with the present course of human affairs. A crowd of incidents would follow each other in thick succession. Armies and fleets would appear to be assembled only to be destroyed, and cities built merely to fall in ruins. There would be the most violent transitions from foreign or intestine war to periods of profound peace, and the works effected during the years of disorder or tranquillity would appear alike superhuman in magnitude.65

But the arguments above target only one of many biases that early geologists faced. Even when they accepted that the Earth had been inhabited by living beings earlier than previously thought, they had no idea that the amount of time was so much greater in relation to the historical era than we now generally accept. You can imagine how disastrous any mistake about the amount of time would be for forming accurate views of past conditions by considering the history of a great nation’s civil and military events as if they occurred over a hundred years instead of two thousand. Such a segment of history would seem more like a story; the events would come off as unbelievable and inconsistent with today’s reality. A series of incidents would happen in quick succession. Armies and fleets would appear to be gathered only to be defeated, and cities would seem to be built just to fall into ruins. There would be sudden swings from foreign or civil war to long periods of deep peace, and the achievements during times of chaos or calm would appear impossibly grand.65

He who should study the monuments of the natural world under the influence of a similar infatuation, must draw a no less exaggerated picture of the energy and violence of causes, and must experience the same insurmountable difficulty in reconciling the former and present state of nature. If we could behold in one view all the volcanic cones thrown up in Iceland, Italy, Sicily, and other parts of Europe, during the last five thousand years, and could see the lavas which have flowed during the same period; the dislocations, subsidences, and elevations caused during earthquakes; the lands added to various deltas, or devoured by the sea, together with the effects of devastation by floods, and imagine that all these events had happened in one year, we must form most exalted ideas of the activity of the agents, and the suddenness of the revolutions. Were an equal amount of change to pass before our eyes in the next year, could we avoid the conclusion that some great crisis of nature was at hand? If geologists, therefore, have misinterpreted the signs of a succession of events, so as to conclude that centuries were implied where the characters imported thousands of years, and thousands of years where the language of Nature signified millions, they could not, if they reasoned logically from such false premises, come to any other conclusion than that the system of the natural world had undergone a complete revolution.

Anyone studying the natural world's landmarks with a similar obsession must paint an equally distorted picture of the forces at work and will face the same overwhelming challenge in reconciling the past and present states of nature. If we could observe all the volcanic cones that have erupted in Iceland, Italy, Sicily, and other parts of Europe over the last five thousand years and see the lavas that have flowed during that time; the shifts, sinkings, and rises caused by earthquakes; the land added to various deltas or swallowed by the sea, along with the destruction from floods, and imagine that all these events occurred in just one year, we would have an extraordinarily heightened sense of the agents' activity and the abruptness of these changes. If an equal amount of change were to happen before us in the next year, could we really dismiss the idea that some major crisis in nature was imminent? If geologists have misinterpreted the signs of a series of events, concluding that centuries were implied when the symbols indicated thousands of years, and thousands of years when Nature's language meant millions, they could not logically reason from such mistaken foundations and arrive at any conclusion other than that the natural world has gone through a total transformation.

We should be warranted in ascribing the erection of the great pyramid to superhuman power, if we were convinced that it was raised in one day; and if we imagine, in the same manner, a continent or mountain-chain to have been elevated during an equally small fraction of the time which was really occupied in upheaving it, we might then be justified in inferring, that the subterranean movements were once far more energetic than in our own times. We know that during one earthquake the coast of Chili may be raised for a hundred miles to the average height of about three feet. A repetition of two thousand shocks, of equal violence, might produce a mountain-chain one hundred miles long, and six thousand feet high. Now, should one or two only of these convulsions happen in a century, it would be consistent with the order of events experienced by the Chilians from the earliest times; but if the whole of them were to occur in the next hundred years, the entire district must be depopulated, scarcely any animals or plants could survive, and the surface would be one confused heap of ruin and desolation.

We could rightfully believe that the construction of the great pyramid was due to superhuman power if we were convinced it was built in a single day. If we similarly imagined that a continent or mountain range was raised in a similarly brief time compared to how long it actually took, we could infer that the underground movements were once much more powerful than they are now. We know that during one earthquake, the coast of Chile can be lifted by an average of about three feet over a hundred miles. If we had two thousand earthquakes of equal strength, that could create a mountain range a hundred miles long and six thousand feet high. If only one or two of these tremors occurred in a century, it would fit with the history experienced by the Chileans from the earliest times. However, if all of them happened in the next hundred years, the entire area would be depopulated, with hardly any plants or animals able to survive, and the landscape would be a chaotic mess of destruction and desolation.

One consequence of undervaluing greatly the quantity of past time, is the apparent coincidence which it occasions of events necessarily disconnected, or which are so unusual, that it would be inconsistent with all calculation of chances to suppose them to happen at one and the same time. When the unlooked-for association of such rare phenomena is witnessed in the present course of nature, it scarcely ever fails to excite a suspicion of the preternatural in those minds which are not firmly convinced of the uniform agency of secondary causes;—as if the death of some individual in whose fate they are interested happens to66 be accompanied by the appearance of a luminous meteor, or a comet, or the shock of an earthquake. It would be only necessary to multiply such coincidences indefinitely, and the mind of every philosopher would be disturbed. Now it would be difficult to exaggerate the number of physical events, many of them most rare and unconnected in their nature, which were imagined by the Woodwardian hypothesis to have happened in the course of a few months; and numerous other examples might be found of popular geological theories, which require us to imagine that a long succession of events happened in a brief and almost momentary period.

One consequence of greatly undervaluing the amount of time that has passed is the apparent coincidence of events that are actually unrelated or so unusual that it seems impossible for them to happen at the same time. When people observe such unexpected associations of rare phenomena in the natural world, it almost always raises suspicions of something unnatural in those who are not firmly convinced of the consistent operation of secondary causes; as if the death of someone they care about happens to be accompanied by the appearance of a bright meteor, a comet, or an earthquake. It would only take multiplying such coincidences endlessly for the mind of any philosopher to be unsettled. Now, it would be hard to overstate the number of physical events, many of which are quite rare and unrelated, that the Woodwardian hypothesis suggested occurred over the span of a few months; and many other examples can be found in popular geological theories that require us to imagine a long series of events happening in a short and almost instantaneous period.

Another liability to error, very nearly allied to the former, arises from the frequent contact of geological monuments referring to very distant periods of time. We often behold, at one glance, the effects of causes which have acted at times incalculably remote, and yet there may be no striking circumstances to mark the occurrence of a great chasm in the chronological series of Nature's archives. In the vast interval of time which may really have elapsed between the results of operations thus compared, the physical condition of the earth may, by slow and insensible modifications, have become entirely altered; one or more races of organic beings may have passed away, and yet have left behind, in the particular region under contemplation, no trace of their existence.

Another source of error, closely related to the previous one, comes from the frequent interaction with geological evidence dating back to very distant times. We often see, all at once, the results of forces that operated in times that are incredibly far away, and yet there might be no obvious signs to indicate a significant gap in the timeline of Nature's records. In the vast amount of time that may have actually passed between the results we compare, the physical state of the earth could have changed completely due to gradual and unnoticed modifications; one or more species may have disappeared entirely, leaving no evidence of their existence in the specific area being examined.

To a mind unconscious of these intermediate events, the passage from one state of things to another must appear so violent, that the idea of revolutions in the system inevitably suggests itself. The imagination is as much perplexed by the deception, as it might be if two distant points in space were suddenly brought into immediate proximity. Let us suppose, for a moment, that a philosopher should lie down to sleep in some arctic wilderness, and then be transferred by a power, such as we read of in tales of enchantment, to a valley in a tropical country, where, on awaking, he might find himself surrounded by birds of brilliant plumage, and all the luxuriance of animal and vegetable forms of which Nature is so prodigal in those regions. The most reasonable supposition, perhaps, which he could make, if by the necromancer's art he were placed in such a situation, would be, that he was dreaming; and if a geologist form theories under a similar delusion, we cannot expect him to preserve more consistency in his speculations than in the train of ideas in an ordinary dream.

To a mind unaware of these intermediate events, the shift from one state of things to another must seem so abrupt that the thought of revolutions in the system naturally comes to mind. The imagination is just as confused by the illusion as it would be if two distant points in space suddenly came close together. Let's imagine, for a moment, that a philosopher goes to sleep in some arctic wilderness and is then magically transported, like in fairy tales, to a valley in a tropical country, where, upon waking, he finds himself surrounded by brightly colored birds and the rich abundance of plants and animals that Nature is so generous with in those areas. The most logical conclusion he might draw, if he were placed in such a situation by magical means, would be that he is dreaming; and if a geologist forms theories under a similar misunderstanding, we can't expect him to maintain more consistency in his ideas than one would in a typical dream.

It may afford, perhaps, a lively illustration of the principle here insisted upon, if I recall to the reader's recollection the legend of the Seven Sleepers. The scene of that popular fable was placed in the two centuries which elapsed between the reign of the emperor Decius and the death of Theodosius the younger. In that interval of time (between the years 249 and 450 of our era) the union of the Roman Empire had been dissolved, and some of its fairest provinces overrun by the barbarians of the north. The seat of government had passed from Rome to Constantinople, and the throne from a pagan persecutor to a succession of Christian and orthodox princes. The genius of the empire had been67 humbled in the dust, and the altars of Diana and Hercules were on the point of being transferred to Catholic saints and martyrs. The legend relates, "that when Decius was still persecuting the Christians, seven noble youths of Ephesus concealed themselves in a spacious cavern in the side of an adjacent mountain, where they were doomed to perish by the tyrant, who gave orders that the entrance should be firmly secured with a pile of huge stones. They immediately fell into a deep slumber, which was miraculously prolonged, without injuring the powers of life, during a period of 187 years. At the end of that time the slaves of Adolius, to whom the inheritance of the mountain had descended, removed the stones to supply materials for some rustic edifice: the light of the sun darted into the cavern, and the Seven Sleepers were permitted to awake. After a slumber, as they thought, of a few hours, they were pressed by the calls of hunger, and resolved that Jamblichus, one of their number, should secretly return to the city to purchase bread for the use of his companions. The youth could no longer recognize the once familiar aspect of his native country, and his surprise was increased by the appearance of a large cross triumphantly erected over the principal gate of Ephesus. His singular dress and obsolete language confounded the baker, to whom he offered an ancient medal of Decius as the current coin of the empire; and Jamblichus, on the suspicion of a secret treasure, was dragged before the judge. Their mutual inquiries produced the amazing discovery, that two centuries were almost elapsed since Jamblichus and his friends had escaped from the rage of a pagan tyrant."123

It might provide a vivid illustration of the principle I’m discussing if I remind you of the story of the Seven Sleepers. This popular fable takes place during the two centuries between the reign of Emperor Decius and the death of Theodosius the Younger. In that time (between the years 249 and 450 AD), the unity of the Roman Empire had fallen apart, and some of its most beautiful provinces were overrun by northern barbarians. The government had shifted from Rome to Constantinople, and the throne had changed from a pagan persecutor to a succession of Christian and orthodox rulers. The spirit of the empire had been67 brought low, and the altars of Diana and Hercules were about to be replaced by those of Catholic saints and martyrs. The legend says that while Decius was still persecuting Christians, seven noble youths from Ephesus hid in a large cave in a nearby mountain, where they were doomed to die by the tyrant, who ordered the entrance to be securely blocked with big stones. They fell into a deep sleep that lasted miraculously for 187 years without harming their life forces. After this time, the slaves of Adolius, who inherited the mountain, removed the stones to use them for a small building: sunlight streamed into the cave, and the Seven Sleepers were allowed to wake up. After what they thought was just a few hours of sleep, hunger struck, and they decided that Jamblichus, one of them, should go back to the city to buy bread for his friends. The young man could no longer recognize what once was his homeland, and his surprise grew when he saw a large cross proudly displayed over the main gate of Ephesus. His unusual clothes and outdated language confused the baker, to whom he offered a classic coin from Decius’s time as if it were current currency; suspecting he had some secret treasure, Jamblichus was taken before the judge. Their questions led to the astonishing discovery that nearly two centuries had passed since Jamblichus and his friends had escaped the fury of a pagan tyrant.123

This legend was received as authentic throughout the Christian world before the end of the sixth century, and was afterwards introduced by Mahomet as a divine revelation into the Koran, and from hence was adopted and adorned by all the nations from Bengal to Africa who professed the Mahometan faith. Some vestiges even of a similar tradition have been discovered in Scandinavia. "This easy and universal belief," observes the philosophical historian of the Decline and Fall, "so expressive of the sense of mankind, may be ascribed to the genuine merit of the fable itself. We imperceptibly advance from youth to age, without observing the gradual, but incessant, change of human affairs; and even, in our larger experience of history, the imagination is accustomed, by a perpetual series of causes and effects, to unite the most distant revolutions. But if the interval between two memorable eras could be instantly annihilated; if it were possible, after a momentary slumber of two hundred years, to display the new world to the eyes of a spectator who still retained a lively and recent impression of the old, his surprise and his reflections would furnish the pleasing subject of a philosophical romance."124

This story was accepted as true across the Christian world before the end of the sixth century, and later was introduced by Muhammad as a divine revelation in the Koran, which was then embraced and enhanced by all the nations from Bengal to Africa that followed the Islamic faith. Some traces of a similar tradition have even been found in Scandinavia. "This simple and widespread belief," notes the philosophical historian of the Decline and Fall, "reflects the thoughts of humanity and can be attributed to the true value of the tale itself. We gradually move from youth to old age without noticing the slow but constant changes in human affairs; and even when we have broader historical knowledge, our imagination, through a continuous chain of causes and effects, tends to connect the most distant events. But if the gap between two significant periods could be instantly closed; if it were possible, after a brief sleep of two hundred years, to reveal the new world to someone who still retained a vivid and recent memory of the old, their astonishment and thoughts would provide a fascinating subject for a philosophical story."124

Prejudices arising from our peculiar position as inhabitants of the land.—The sources of prejudice hitherto considered may be deemed 68peculiar for the most part to the infancy of the science, but others are common to the first cultivators of geology and to ourselves, and are all singularly calculated to produce the same deception, and to strengthen our belief that the course of nature in the earlier ages differed widely from that now established. Although these circumstances cannot be fully explained without assuming some things as proved, which it will be the object of another part of this work to demonstrate, it may be well to allude to them briefly in this place.

Prejudices that come from our unique position as residents of this land.—The sources of prejudice we've talked about so far can mostly be seen as specific to the early days of the science, but others are common to the initial pioneers of geology and us, and they all happen to create the same misconceptions, reinforcing our belief that nature’s processes in earlier times were very different from what we see today. While we can’t fully clarify these circumstances without assuming certain things as established—which will be the focus of another section of this work—it’s worth mentioning them briefly here.

The first and greatest difficulty, then, consists in an habitual unconsciousness that our position as observers is essentially unfavorable, when we endeavor to estimate the nature and magnitude of the changes now in progress. In consequence of our inattention to this subject, we are liable to serious mistakes in contrasting the present with former states of the globe. As dwellers on the land, we inhabit about a fourth part of the surface; and that portion is almost exclusively a theatre of decay, and not of reproduction. We know, indeed, that new deposits are annually formed in seas and lakes, and that every year some new igneous rocks are produced in the bowels of the earth, but we cannot watch the progress of their formation; and as they are only present to our minds by the aid of reflection, it requires an effort both of the reason and the imagination to appreciate duly their importance. It is, therefore, not surprising that we estimate very imperfectly the result of operations thus invisible to us; and that, when analogous results of former epochs are presented to our inspection, we cannot immediately recognize the analogy. He who has observed the quarrying of stone from a rock, and has seen it shipped for some distant port, and then endeavors to conceive what kind of edifice will be raised by the materials, is in the same predicament as a geologist, who, while he is confined to the land, sees the decomposition of rocks, and the transportation of matter by rivers to the sea, and then endeavors to picture to himself the new strata which Nature is building beneath the waters.

The first and biggest challenge is that we often unconsciously overlook the fact that our role as observers is inherently limited when trying to assess the nature and scale of the changes happening around us. Because we don’t pay enough attention to this issue, we can easily make mistakes when comparing the present to earlier conditions of the Earth. As people who live on land, we occupy only about a quarter of the Earth's surface, and that part is mostly a stage for decay rather than growth. We know that new deposits are formed every year in oceans and lakes, and that some new volcanic rocks are created deep within the Earth, but we can't see how they form. Since these processes only come to our minds through reflection, it takes effort from both our reasoning and our imagination to fully grasp their significance. It’s therefore not surprising that we have a limited understanding of results from processes that are invisible to us; and when we look at similar results from the past, we often fail to recognize the similarities right away. Someone who has watched stone being quarried from a rock, shipped off to a distant location, and then tries to imagine what kind of building will be constructed from those materials is in the same situation as a geologist who, while being limited to the land, observes the breakdown of rocks and the movement of materials by rivers to the ocean, and then tries to envision the new layers that Nature is forming beneath the water.

Prejudices arising from our not seeing subterranean changes.—Nor is his position less unfavorable when, beholding a volcanic eruption, he tries to conceive what changes the column of lava has produced, in its passage upwards, on the intersected strata; or what form the melted matter may assume at great depths on cooling; or what may be the extent of the subterranean rivers and reservoirs of liquid matter far beneath the surface. It should, therefore, be remembered, that the task imposed on those who study the earth's history requires no ordinary share of discretion; for we are precluded from collating the corresponding parts of the system of things as it exists now, and as it existed at former periods. If we were inhabitants of another element—if the great ocean were our domain, instead of the narrow limits of the land, our difficulties would be considerably lessened; while, on the other hand, there can be little doubt, although the reader may, perhaps, smile at the bare suggestion of such an idea, that an amphibious being, who should possess our faculties, would still more easily arrive at sound theoretical69 opinions in geology, since he might behold, on the one hand, the decomposition of rocks in the atmosphere, or the transportation of matter by running water; and, on the other, examine the deposition of sediment in the sea, and the imbedding of animal and vegetable remains in new strata. He might ascertain, by direct observation, the action of a mountain torrent, as well as of a marine current; might compare the products of volcanoes poured out upon the land with those ejected beneath the waters; and might mark, on the one hand, the growth of the forest, and, on the other, that of the coral reef. Yet, even with these advantages, he would be liable to fall into the greatest errors, when endeavoring to reason on rocks of subterranean origin. He would seek in vain, within the sphere of his observation, for any direct analogy to the process of their formation, and would therefore be in danger of attributing them, wherever they are upraised to view, to some "primeval state of nature."

Prejudices arising from our not seeing underground changes.—His situation isn’t any better when, witnessing a volcanic eruption, he tries to imagine the changes the lava column has caused as it moves upward through the layers; or what shape the melted material might take deep down as it cools; or how extensive the underground rivers and reservoirs of liquid matter are far beneath the surface. It should be noted that the task faced by those studying the earth's history requires a considerable amount of discretion; because we can’t directly compare the relevant parts of the current system to how things were in the past. If we lived in a different element—if the vast ocean was our environment instead of the limited expanses of land, our challenges would be greatly reduced. On the flip side, although the reader might find the mere suggestion amusing, there is little doubt that an amphibious being with our capabilities would find it even easier to form accurate theoretical opinions in geology. This being could observe, on one side, the breakdown of rocks in the atmosphere, or the transportation of materials by flowing water; and, on the other, examine sediment deposition in the ocean and the embedding of plant and animal remains in new layers. They could directly observe the effects of a mountain torrent as well as a marine current; compare the outputs of volcanoes on land with those released underwater; and notice, on one hand, forest growth and, on the other, coral reef formation. Yet, even with these advantages, they would still be prone to major mistakes while trying to reason about underground rocks. They would look in vain, within their observation limits, for any direct analogy to how those rocks formed and might mistakenly attribute them, wherever they become visible, to some "primitive state of nature."

But if we may be allowed so far to indulge the imagination, as to suppose a being entirely confined to the nether world—some "dusky melancholy sprite," like Umbriel, who could "flit on sooty pinions to the central earth," but who was never permitted to "sully the fair face of light," and emerge into the regions of water and of air; and if this being should busy himself in investigating the structure of the globe, he might frame theories the exact converse of those usually adopted by human philosophers. He might infer that the stratified rocks, containing shells and other organic remains, were the oldest of created things, belonging to some original and nascent state of the planet. "Of these masses," he might say, "whether they consist of loose incoherent sand, soft clay, or solid stone, none have been formed in modern times. Every year some part of them are broken and shattered by earthquakes, or melted by volcanic fire; and when they cool down slowly from a state of fusion, they assume a new and more crystalline form, no longer exhibiting that stratified disposition and those curious impressions and fantastic markings, by which they were previously characterized. This process cannot have been carried on for an indefinite time, for in that case all the stratified rocks would long ere this have been fused and crystallized. It is therefore probable that the whole planet once consisted of these mysterious and curiously bedded formations at a time when the volcanic fire had not yet been brought into activity. Since that period there seems to have been a gradual development of heat; and this augmentation we may expect to continue till the whole globe shall be in a state of fluidity and incandescence."

But if we allow ourselves to imagine a being entirely confined to the underworld—some "dark, sad spirit," like Umbriel, who could "glide on black wings to the central earth," but who was never allowed to "tarnish the beautiful face of light," and step into the realms of water and air; and if this being were to focus on understanding the structure of the planet, he might come up with theories that are the exact opposite of what human philosophers usually accept. He might conclude that the layered rocks, containing shells and other organic remains, were the oldest things created, belonging to some original and early state of the planet. "Of these masses," he might say, "whether they’re made of loose, disorganized sand, soft clay, or solid stone, none of them have formed in modern times. Each year, some part of them gets broken and shattered by earthquakes, or melted by volcanic fire; and when they cool down slowly from a state of melting, they take on a new and more crystalline form, no longer showing that layered arrangement and those interesting impressions and strange markings that characterized them before. This process cannot have gone on indefinitely, because if it had, all the layered rocks would have been melted and crystallized long ago. It’s therefore likely that the whole planet once consisted of these strange and intricately layered formations at a time when volcanic activity hadn’t yet begun. Since then, there seems to have been a gradual increase in heat; and we can expect this increase to continue until the entire globe is in a state of liquid and glowing heat."

Such might be the system of the Gnome at the very time that the followers of Leibnitz, reasoning on what they saw on the outer surface, might be teaching the opposite doctrine of gradual refrigeration, and averring that the earth had begun its career as a fiery comet, and might be destined hereafter to become a frozen mass. The tenets of the schools of the nether and of the upper world would be directly opposed to each other, for both would partake of the prejudices inevitably re70sulting from the continual contemplation of one class of phenomena to the exclusion of another. Man observes the annual decomposition of crystalline and igneous rocks, and may sometimes see their conversion into stratified deposits; but he cannot witness the reconversion of the sedimentary into the crystalline by subterranean fire. He is in the habit of regarding all the sedimentary rocks as more recent than the unstratified, for the same reason that we may suppose him to fall into the opposite error if he saw the origin of the igneous class only.

Such might be the system of the Gnome at the very time that the followers of Leibnitz, reasoning based on what they saw on the surface, might be teaching the opposite idea of gradual cooling, claiming that the earth started as a fiery comet and might eventually become a frozen mass. The beliefs of the schools from the underworld and the upper world would be directly opposed to each other, as both would be influenced by the biases that come from constantly focusing on one type of phenomenon while ignoring another. Humans observe the yearly breakdown of crystalline and volcanic rocks, and might sometimes see their transformation into layered deposits; however, they cannot witness the transformation of sedimentary rocks back into crystalline rocks through underground fire. They tend to view all sedimentary rocks as newer than the unlayered ones, for the same reason that we might expect them to make the opposite mistake if they only saw the origins of the volcanic rocks.

It was not an impossible contingency, that astronomers might have been placed at some period in a situation much resembling that in which the geologist seems to stand at present. If the Italians, for example, in the early part of the twelfth century, had discovered at Amalfi, instead of the pandects of Justinian, some ancient manuscripts filled with astronomical observations relating to a period of three thousand years, and made by some ancient geometers who possessed optical instruments as perfect as any in modern Europe, they would probably, on consulting these memorials, have come to a conclusion that there had been a great revolution in the solar and sidereal systems. "Many primary and secondary planets," they might say, "are enumerated in these tables, which exist no longer. Their positions are assigned with such precision that we may assure ourselves that there is nothing in their place at present but the blue ether. Where one star is visible to us, these documents represent several thousands. Some of those which are now single consisted then of two separate bodies, often distinguished by different colors, and revolving periodically round a common centre of gravity. There is nothing analogous to them in the universe at present; for they were neither fixed stars nor planets, but seem to have stood in the mutual relation of sun and planet to each other. We must conclude, therefore, that there has occurred, at no distant period, a tremendous catastrophe, whereby thousands of worlds have been annihilated at once, and some heavenly bodies absorbed into the substance of others."

It wasn't impossible to think that astronomers might have found themselves in a situation similar to what geologists are facing now. If, for instance, the Italians in the early twelfth century had discovered at Amalfi, instead of Justinian's legal texts, some ancient manuscripts filled with astronomical observations covering a period of three thousand years—created by ancient geometers who had optical instruments as advanced as those in modern Europe—they would likely conclude, upon reviewing these documents, that there had been a significant change in the solar and stellar systems. They might say, "Many primary and secondary planets are listed in these tables, which no longer exist. Their positions are noted with such accuracy that we can be confident that nothing is there now except for the blue expanse of space. Where we see one star, these records indicate several thousand. Some stars that appear solitary to us were once two separate bodies, often distinguished by different colors, orbiting around a common center of gravity. There is nothing comparable to them in the universe today; they were neither fixed stars nor planets, but seemed to have a relationship similar to that of a sun and planet to each other. We must conclude, therefore, that a massive catastrophe occurred not long ago, resulting in the destruction of thousands of worlds at once, and the absorption of some celestial bodies into others."

When such doctrines had prevailed for ages, the discovery of some of the worlds, supposed to have been lost (the satellites of Jupiter, for example), by aid of the first rude telescope invented after the revival of science, would not dissipate the delusion, for the whole burden of proof would now be thrown on those who insisted on the stability of the system from a remote period, and these philosophers would be required to demonstrate the existence of all the worlds said to have been annihilated.

When these beliefs had been around for centuries, the discovery of some of the worlds that were thought to be lost (like Jupiter's moons, for instance), using the first basic telescope invented after science was revived, wouldn't change minds. The entire responsibility for proof would now fall on those who claimed that the system had been stable for a long time, and those philosophers would need to prove the existence of all the worlds that were said to have been destroyed.

Such popular prejudices would be most unfavorable to the advancement of astronomy; for, instead of persevering in the attempt to improve their instruments, and laboriously to make and record observations, the greater number would despair of verifying the continued existence of the heavenly bodies not visible to the naked eye. Instead of confessing the extent of their ignorance, and striving to remove it by bringing to light new facts, they would indulge in the more easy and71 indolent employment of framing imaginary theories concerning catastrophes and mighty revolutions in the system of the universe.

Such common biases would seriously hinder the progress of astronomy; instead of continuing to refine their tools and diligently making and recording observations, most people would give up on proving the existence of celestial bodies that can’t be seen with the naked eye. Rather than admitting how much they don’t know and working to change that by uncovering new facts, they would prefer the simpler and lazier task of coming up with made-up theories about disasters and huge changes in the universe's system.

For more than two centuries the shelly strata of the Subapennine hills afforded matter of speculation to the early geologists of Italy, and few of them had any suspicion that similar deposits were then forming in the neighboring sea. They were as unconscious of the continued action of causes still producing similar effects, as the astronomers, in the case above supposed, of the existence of certain heavenly bodies still giving and reflecting light, and performing their movements as of old. Some imagined that the strata, so rich in organic remains, instead of being due to secondary agents, had been so created in the beginning of things by the fiat of the Almighty. Others, as we have seen, ascribed the imbedded fossil bodies to some plastic power which resided in the earth in the early ages of the world. In what manner were these dogmas at length exploded? The fossil relics were carefully compared with their living analogues, and all doubts as to their organic origin were eventually dispelled. So, also, in regard to the nature of the containing beds of mud, sand, and limestone: those parts of the bottom of the sea were examined where shells are now becoming annually entombed in new deposits. Donati explored the bed of the Adriatic, and found the closest resemblance between the strata there forming, and those which constituted hills above a thousand feet high in various parts of the Italian peninsula. He ascertained by dredging that living testacea were there grouped together in precisely the same manner as were their fossil analogues in the inland strata; and while some of the recent shells of the Adriatic were becoming incrusted with calcareous rock, he observed that others had been newly buried in sand and clay, precisely as fossil shells occur in the Subapennine hills. This discovery of the identity of modern and ancient submarine operations was not made without the aid of artificial instruments, which, like the telescope, brought phenomena into view not otherwise within the sphere of human observation.

For over two hundred years, the fossil-rich layers of the Subapennine hills sparked curiosity among early geologists in Italy, and few of them realized that similar deposits were being formed in the nearby sea. They were as unaware of the ongoing processes still creating similar effects, as astronomers might be unaware of certain celestial bodies that continue to shine and move just as they always have. Some believed that the layers, abundant with organic remains, were not formed by secondary agents but were created at the beginning of time by the will of the Almighty. Others, as we have seen, attributed the embedded fossil remains to some formative power that existed in the earth in the early days of the world. How were these beliefs ultimately debunked? The fossil remains were thoughtfully compared with their living counterparts, and any doubts about their organic origin were eventually cleared up. The same was true for the nature of the surrounding layers of mud, sand, and limestone: those areas of the sea floor were examined where shells are now being buried annually in new deposits. Donati explored the Adriatic Seabed and found a striking similarity between the layers forming there and those that made up hills over one thousand feet high in various parts of the Italian peninsula. He discovered through dredging that living shellfish were grouped together in exactly the same way as their fossil counterparts in the inland layers; while some of the recent shells in the Adriatic were beginning to get coated with calcareous rock, he noticed that others had been recently buried in sand and clay, just like fossil shells found in the Subapennine hills. This revelation of the connection between modern and ancient underwater processes was not achieved without the help of artificial instruments, which, like the telescope, revealed phenomena that were otherwise beyond human observation.

In like manner, the volcanic rocks of the Vicentin had been studied in the beginning of the last century; but no geologist suspected, before the time of Arduino, that these were composed of ancient submarine lavas. During many years of controversy, the popular opinion inclined to a belief that basalt and rocks of the same class had been precipitated from a chaotic fluid, or an ocean which rose at successive periods over the continents, charged with the component elements of the rocks in question. Few will now dispute that it would have been difficult to invent a theory more distant from the truth; yet we must cease to wonder that it gained so many proselytes, when we remember that its claims to probability arose partly from the very circumstance of its confirming the assumed want of analogy between geological causes and those now in action. By what train of investigations were geologists induced at length to reject these views, and to assent to the igneous origin of the trappean formations? By an72 examination of volcanoes now active, and by comparing their structure and the composition of their lavas with the ancient trap-rocks.

Similarly, the volcanic rocks of the Vicentin were studied at the start of the last century; however, no geologist suspected, before Arduino's time, that these rocks were made up of ancient underwater lavas. For many years, popular opinion leaned towards the belief that basalt and similar rocks had formed from a chaotic fluid or an ocean that intermittently flooded the continents, carrying the elements that make up those rocks. Nowadays, few would argue that it would have been hard to come up with a theory more removed from reality; still, we shouldn't be surprised that it gained so many followers, considering that its appeal came partly from aligning with the perceived lack of analogy between geological processes and those happening today. What line of investigation finally led geologists to abandon these views and accept the volcanic origin of the trap formations? Through an examination of currently active volcanoes and by comparing their structure and the makeup of their lavas with the ancient trap rocks.

The establishment, from time to time, of numerous points of identification, drew at length from geologists a reluctant admission, that there was more correspondence between the condition of the globe at remote eras and now, and more uniformity in the laws which have regulated the changes of its surface, than they at first imagined. If, in this state of the science, they still despaired of reconciling every class of geological phenomena to the operations of ordinary causes, even by straining analogy to the utmost limits of credibility, we might have expected, at least, that the balance of probability would now have been presumed to incline towards the close analogy of the ancient and modern causes. But, after repeated experience of the failure of attempts to speculate on geological monuments, as belonging to a distinct order of things, new sects continued to persevere in the principles adopted by their predecessors. They still began, as each new problem presented itself, whether relating to the animate or inanimate world, to assume an original and dissimilar order of nature; and when at length they approximated, or entirely came round to an opposite opinion, it was always with the feeling, that they were conceding what they had been justified à priori in deeming improbable. In a word, the same men who, as natural philosophers, would have been most incredulous respecting any extraordinary deviations from the known course of nature, if reported to have happened in their own time, were equally disposed, as geologists, to expect the proofs of such deviations at every period of the past.

The periodic establishment of various identification points eventually led geologists to reluctantly accept that there is more similarity between the state of the Earth in ancient times and now, and more consistency in the laws that have governed the changes to its surface, than they initially thought. Even in this stage of the science, if they were still doubtful about reconciling every type of geological phenomenon with the effects of ordinary causes, even by pushing the limits of analogy, we might have expected that the likelihood would now be presumed to favor the close similarity between ancient and modern causes. However, after repeatedly experiencing the failure of attempts to analyze geological records as belonging to a distinct category, new factions continued to stick to the principles followed by their predecessors. They still began, with each new issue that arose, whether related to living or non-living things, to assume an original and different order of nature; and when they eventually converged, or completely shifted to an opposite viewpoint, it was always with the sense that they were conceding something they had previously deemed improbable à priori. In short, the same individuals who, as natural philosophers, would have been the most skeptical about any extraordinary deviations from the known course of nature if reported to have happened in their own time, were equally inclined, as geologists, to expect evidence of such deviations at every point in the past.

I shall proceed in the following chapters to enumerate some of the principal difficulties still opposed to the theory of the uniform nature and energy of the causes which have worked successive changes in the crust of the earth, and in the condition of its living inhabitants. The discussion of so important a question on the present occasion may appear premature, but it is one which naturally arises out of a review of the former history of the science. It is, of course, impossible to enter into such speculative topics, without occasionally carrying the novice beyond his depth, and appealing to facts and conclusions with which he will be unacquainted, until he has studied some elementary work on geology, but it may be useful to excite his curiosity, and lead him to study such works by calling his attention at once to some of the principal points of controversy.125

I will discuss in the following chapters some of the main challenges facing the theory of the consistent nature and energy of the causes that have led to the ongoing changes in the Earth's crust and the conditions of its living organisms. Addressing such a significant topic at this point may seem a bit early, but it naturally comes up when reviewing the past developments in the field. It's important to note that diving into these speculative subjects can sometimes leave beginners feeling lost, as they may need to reference facts and conclusions that they are unfamiliar with until they've studied some basic geology. However, it could be helpful to spark their interest and encourage them to explore these subjects further by highlighting some key areas of debate.125


CHAPTER VI.

DOCTRINE OF THE DISCORDANCE OF THE ANCIENT AND MODERN CAUSES OF CHANGE CONTROVERTED.

Climate of the Northern Hemisphere formerly different—Direct proofs from the organic remains of the Italian strata—Proofs from analogy derived from extinct quadrupeds—Imbedding of animals in icebergs—Siberian mammoths—Evidence in regard to temperature, from the fossils of tertiary and secondary rocks—From the plants of the coal formation—Northern limit of these fossils—Whether such plants could endure the long continuance of an arctic night.

Climate of the Northern Hemisphere used to be different—Direct evidence from the organic remains found in Italian layers—Evidence from comparisons drawn from extinct mammals—Animals trapped in icebergs—Siberian mammoths—Temperature evidence drawn from fossils of tertiary and secondary rocks—From the plants found in coal deposits—Northern limit of these fossils—Whether such plants could survive the prolonged arctic night.

Climate of the Northern hemisphere formerly different.—Proofs of former revolutions in climate, as deduced from fossil remains, have afforded one of the most popular objections to the theory which endeavors to explain all geological changes by reference to those now in progress on the earth. The probable causes, therefore, of fluctuations in climate, may first be treated of.

Climate of the Northern hemisphere previously different.—Evidence of past climate changes, inferred from fossil remains, has provided one of the most common challenges to the theory that attempts to explain all geological changes based on current processes happening on Earth. Thus, we can first discuss the likely causes of climate fluctuations.

That the climate of the Northern hemisphere has undergone an important change, and that its mean annual temperature must once have more nearly resembled that now experienced within the tropics, was the opinion of some of the first naturalists who investigated the contents of the ancient strata. Their conjecture became more probable when the shells and corals of the older tertiary and many secondary rocks were carefully examined; for the organic remains of these formations were found to be intimately connected by generic affinity with species now living in warmer latitudes. At a later period, many reptiles, such as turtles, tortoises, and large saurian animals, were discovered in European formations in great abundance; and they supplied new and powerful arguments, from analogy, in support of the doctrine, that the heat of the climate had been great when our secondary strata were deposited. Lastly, when the botanist turned his attention to the specific determination of fossil plants, the evidence acquired still fuller confirmation; for the flora of a country is peculiarly influenced by temperature: and the ancient vegetation of the earth might have been expected more readily than the forms of animals, to have afforded conflicting proofs, had the popular theory been without foundation. When the examination of fossil remains was extended to rocks in the most northern parts of Europe and North America, and even to the Arctic regions, indications of the same revolution in climate were discovered.

That the climate of the Northern Hemisphere has experienced a significant change, and that its average annual temperature must have once been more similar to what we now see in the tropics, was the belief of some of the early naturalists who studied the ancient layers of rock. Their theory gained more credibility when the shells and corals from older tertiary and many secondary rocks were closely examined; the organic remains from these formations were found to be closely related to species currently found in warmer regions. Later, many reptiles, such as turtles, tortoises, and large dinosaurs, were found in abundance in European formations, providing new and compelling evidence, by comparison, supporting the idea that the climate was much warmer when our secondary layers were formed. Lastly, when botanists focused on identifying fossil plants, the findings provided even stronger confirmation; because the plant life of an area is heavily influenced by temperature, the ancient vegetation might have been expected to show conflicting evidence if the common theory had no basis. When researchers looked at fossil remains in the northernmost regions of Europe and North America, and even in the Arctic, signs of the same climatic shift were found.

It cannot be said, that in this, as in many other departments of geology, we have investigated the phenomena of former eras, and neglected those of the present state of things. On the contrary, since the first agitation of this interesting question, the accessions to our knowledge of living animals and plants have been immense, and have far74 surpassed all the data previously obtained for generalizing on the relation of certain types of organization to particular climates. The tropical and temperate zones of South America and of Australia have been explored; and, on close comparison, it has been found that scarcely any of the species of the animate creation in these extensive continents are identical with those inhabiting the old world. Yet the zoologist and botanist, well acquainted with the geographical distribution of organic beings in other parts of the globe, would have been able, if distinct groups of species had been presented to them from these regions, to recognize those which had been collected from latitudes within, and those which were brought from without the tropics.

It can't be said that, in this area as in many others in geology, we've only looked into the phenomena of past eras and ignored the current state of things. On the contrary, since the initial exploration of this fascinating topic, our knowledge of living animals and plants has grown tremendously and has far74 outpaced all the information we had before for understanding how certain types of organisms relate to specific climates. The tropical and temperate regions of South America and Australia have been thoroughly studied; and upon careful comparison, it has been found that very few species in these vast continents are identical to those found in the old world. However, a zoologist or botanist who is familiar with the geographical distribution of living beings in other parts of the world would have been able to identify distinct groups of species from these regions—recognizing which ones were collected from within the tropics and which came from outside of them.

Before I attempt to explain the probable causes of great vicissitudes of temperature on the earth's surface, I shall take a rapid view of some of the principal data which appear to support the popular opinions now entertained on the subject. To insist on the soundness of these inferences, is the more necessary, because some zoologists have undertaken to vindicate the uniformity of the laws of nature, not by accounting for former fluctuations in climate, but by denying the value of the evidence in their favor.126

Before I try to explain the likely reasons for the significant temperature changes on the earth's surface, I'll quickly review some key data that seem to back up the popular beliefs about this topic. It's important to emphasize the validity of these conclusions because some zoologists have taken it upon themselves to defend the consistency of nature's laws, not by explaining past climate variations but by dismissing the evidence that supports them.126

Proofs from fossil shells in tertiary strata.—In Sicily, Calabria, and in the neighborhood of Naples, the fossil testacea of the most modern tertiary formations belong almost entirely to species now inhabiting the Mediterranean; but as we proceed northwards in the Italian peninsula we find in the strata called Subapennine an assemblage of fossil shells departing somewhat more widely from the type of the neighboring seas. The proportion of species identifiable with those now living in the Mediterranean is still considerable; but it no longer predominates, as in the South of Italy and part of Sicily, over the unknown species. Although occurring in localities which are removed several degrees farther from the equator (as at Sienna, Parma, Asti, &c.), the shells yield clear indications of a warmer climate. This evidence is of great weight, and is not neutralized by any facts of a conflicting character; such, for instance, as the association, in the same group, of individuals referable to species now confined to arctic regions. Whenever any of the fossil shells are identified with living species foreign to the Mediterranean, it is not in the Northern Ocean, but nearer the tropics, that they must be sought: on the other hand, the associated unknown species belong, for the most part, to genera which are now most largely developed in equinoctial regions, as, for example, the genera Cancellaria, Cassidaria, Pleurotoma, Conus, and Cypræa.

Proofs from fossil shells in tertiary strata.—In Sicily, Calabria, and around Naples, the fossil shells from the most recent tertiary formations mostly belong to species that currently inhabit the Mediterranean. However, as we move northward in the Italian peninsula, we find in the layers called Subapennine a collection of fossil shells that differ more significantly from the types found in the nearby seas. The number of species that can be matched with those currently living in the Mediterranean is still substantial, but it no longer dominates as it does in southern Italy and parts of Sicily, where there are many unknown species. Even in locations that are positioned several degrees further from the equator (like Sienna, Parma, Asti, etc.), the shells show clear signs of a warmer climate. This evidence is very strong and is not contradicted by any opposing facts; for example, the presence of individuals from species now found only in polar regions within the same group. Whenever any fossil shells are identified with living species that are not part of the Mediterranean, they must be found not in the Northern Ocean but closer to the tropics. On the other hand, the associated unknown species mostly belong to genera that are now most commonly found in tropical regions, such as the genera Cancellaria, Cassidaria, Pleurotoma, Conus, and Cypræa.

On comparing the fossils of the tertiary deposits of Paris and London with those of Bourdeaux, and these again with the more modern strata of Sicily, we should at first expect that they would each indicate a higher temperature in proportion as they are situated farther to the 75south. But the contrary is true; of the shells belonging to these several groups, whether freshwater or marine, some are of extinct, others of living species. Those found in the older, or Eocene, deposits of Paris and London, although six or seven degrees to the north of the Miocene strata at Bourdeaux, afford evidence of a warmer climate; while those of Bourdeaux imply that the sea in which they lived was of a higher temperature than that of Sicily, where the shelly strata were formed six or seven degrees nearer to the equator. In these cases the greater antiquity of the several formations (the Parisian being the oldest and the Sicilian the newest) has more than counterbalanced the influence which latitude would otherwise exert, and this phenomenon clearly points to a gradual and successive refrigeration of climate.

When we compare the fossils from the tertiary deposits of Paris and London with those from Bordeaux, and then with the more modern layers of Sicily, we might initially expect that each would show a higher temperature the further south they are located. However, the opposite is true; among the shells from these different groups, whether they are freshwater or marine, some belong to extinct species while others are from living species. The fossils found in the older Eocene deposits of Paris and London, despite being six or seven degrees north of the Miocene layers in Bordeaux, provide evidence of a warmer climate. Meanwhile, the fossils from Bordeaux suggest that the sea they inhabited was warmer than that of Sicily, where the shelly layers formed six or seven degrees closer to the equator. In these cases, the greater age of the various formations (with the Parisian being the oldest and the Sicilian the youngest) has more than offset the influence latitude would normally have, and this phenomenon clearly indicates a gradual and ongoing cooling of the climate.

Siberian Mammoths.—It will naturally be asked, whether some recent geological discoveries bringing evidence to light of a colder, or as it has been termed "glacial epoch," towards the close of the tertiary periods throughout the northern hemisphere, does not conflict with the theory above alluded to, of a warmer temperature having prevailed in the eras of the Eocene, Miocene, and Pliocene formations. In answer to this inquiry, it may certainly be affirmed, that an oscillation of climate has occurred in times immediately antecedent to the peopling of the earth by man; but proof of the intercalation of a less genial climate at an era when nearly all the marine and terrestrial testacea had already become specifically the same as those now living, by no means rebuts the conclusion previously drawn, in favor of a warmer condition of the globe, during the ages which elapsed while the tertiary strata were deposited. In some of the most superficial patches of sand, gravel, and loam, scattered very generally over Europe, and containing recent shells, the remains of extinct species of land quadrupeds have been found, especially in places where the alluvial matter appears to have been washed into small lakes, or into depressions in the plains bordering ancient rivers. Similar deposits have also been lodged in rents and caverns of rocks, where they may have been swept in by land floods, or introduced by engulphed rivers during changes in the physical geography of these countries. The various circumstances under which the bones of animals have been thus preserved, will be more fully considered hereafter;127 I shall only state here, that among the extinct mammalia thus entombed, we find species of the elephant, rhinoceros, hippopotamus, bear, hyæna, lion, tiger, monkey (macacus128), and many others; consisting partly of genera now confined to warmer regions.

Siberian Mammoths.—It’s natural to wonder whether some recent geological discoveries, which provide evidence of a colder period, or as it’s called, a "glacial epoch," at the end of the tertiary periods in the northern hemisphere, contradict the theory that a warmer climate existed during the Eocene, Miocene, and Pliocene eras. In response to this question, it can definitely be stated that climate fluctuations occurred just before humans populated the earth; however, evidence of a less hospitable climate during a time when almost all marine and land species had already become similar to those that exist today does not invalidate the earlier conclusion supporting a warmer global climate during the ages when the tertiary layers were formed. In some of the shallow layers of sand, gravel, and loam found scattered throughout Europe, which contain recent shells, the remains of extinct land mammals have been discovered, especially in areas where the sediment seems to have been washed into small lakes or low areas in the plains near ancient rivers. Similar deposits have also accumulated in crevices and caves in rocks, where they may have been carried in by land floods or brought in by swallowed rivers during changes in the physical geography of these regions. The different conditions under which these animal bones have been preserved will be explored in more detail later;127 I will just mention here that among the extinct mammals found entombed, we see species of elephant, rhinoceros, hippopotamus, bear, hyena, lion, tiger, monkey (macacus128), and many others; some of these genera are now limited to warmer areas.

It is certainly probable that when some of these quadrupeds abounded in Europe, the climate was milder than that now experienced. The hippopotamus, for example, is now only met with where the temperature of the water is warm and nearly uniform throughout the year, and 76where the rivers are never frozen over. Yet when the great fossil species (Hippopotamus major, Cuv.) inhabited England, the testacea of our country were nearly the same as those now existing, and the climate cannot be supposed to have been very hot. The bones of this animal have lately been found by Mr. Strickland, together with those of a bear and other mammalia, at Cropthorn, near Evesham, in Worcestershire, in alluvial sand, together with twenty-three species of terrestrial and freshwater shells, all, with two exceptions, of British species. The bed of sand, containing the shells and bones, reposes on lias, and is covered with alternating strata of gravel, sand, and loam.129

It’s likely that when some of these four-legged animals were plentiful in Europe, the climate was milder than it is today. The hippopotamus, for instance, is now only found where the water temperature is warm and stays consistent throughout the year, and where the rivers never freeze. Yet when the large fossil species (Hippopotamus major, Cuv.) lived in England, the shellfish in our country were nearly the same as those that exist now, and the climate couldn’t have been very hot. Recently, Mr. Strickland discovered bones of this animal, along with those of a bear and other mammals, at Cropthorn, near Evesham, in Worcestershire, in alluvial sand, along with twenty-three species of land and freshwater shells, all but two being British species. The layer of sand that contains the shells and bones sits on lias and is covered with alternating layers of gravel, sand, and loam.129

The mammoth also appears to have existed in England when the temperature of our latitudes could not have been very different from that which now prevails; for remains of this animal have been found at North Cliff, in the county of York, in a lacustrine formation, in which all the land and freshwater shells, thirteen in number, can be identified with species and varieties now existing in that county. Bones of the bison, also, an animal now inhabiting a cold or temperate climate, have been found in the same place. That these quadrupeds, and the indigenous species of testacea associated with them, were all contemporary inhabitants of Yorkshire, has been established by unequivocal proof. The Rev. W. V. Vernon Harcourt caused a pit to be sunk to the depth of twenty-two feet through undisturbed strata, in which the remains of the mammoth were found imbedded, together with the shells, in a deposit which had evidently resulted from tranquil waters.130

The mammoth seems to have lived in England when the climate in our regions was likely not very different from what it is today; remains of this animal have been discovered at North Cliff in York County, within a lakebed formation, where all the land and freshwater shells—thirteen in total—can be matched to species and varieties currently found in that area. Bones of the bison, an animal that now lives in cold or temperate climates, have also been found in the same location. It's been clearly demonstrated that these four-legged animals, along with the local shellfish accompanying them, all coexisted in Yorkshire. The Rev. W. V. Vernon Harcourt had a pit dug down to twenty-two feet through undisturbed layers, where the remains of the mammoth were found embedded alongside the shells in a deposit that clearly came from calm waters.130

In the valley of the Thames, as at Ilford and Grays, in Essex, bones of the elephant and rhinoceros occur in strata abounding in freshwater shells of the genera Unio, Cyclas, Paludina, Valvata, Ancylus, and others. These fossil shells belong for the most part to species now living in the same district, yet some few of them are extinct, as, for example, a species of Cyrena, a genus no longer inhabiting Europe, and now entirely restricted to warmer latitudes.

In the Thames Valley, like in Ilford and Grays in Essex, bones of elephants and rhinoceroses are found in layers rich with freshwater shells from genera like Unio, Cyclas, Paludina, Valvata, Ancylus, and others. Most of these fossil shells come from species that are still alive in the same area, but a few are extinct, such as a species of Cyrena, which no longer lives in Europe and is now completely limited to warmer regions.

When reasoning on such phenomena, the reader must always bear in mind that the fossil individuals belonged to species of elephant, rhinoceros, hippopotamus, bear, tiger, and hyæna, distinct from those which now dwell within or near the tropics. Dr. Fleming, in a discussion on this subject, has well remarked that a near resemblance in form and osteological structure is not always followed, in the existing creation, by a similarity of geographical distribution; and we must therefore be on our guard against deciding too confidently, from mere analogy of anatomical structure, respecting the habits and physiological peculiarities of species now no more. "The zebra delights to roam over the tropical plains, while the horse can maintain its existence throughout an Iceland winter. The buffalo, like the zebra, prefers a high temperature, and cannot thrive even where the common ox prospers. The musk-ox, on the other hand, though nearly resembling the buffalo, prefers the stinted 77herbage of the arctic regions, and is able, by its periodical migrations, to outlive a northern winter. The jackal (Canis aureus) inhabits Africa, the warmer parts of Asia, and Greece; while the isatis (Canis lagopus) resides in the arctic regions. The African hare and the polar hare have their geographical distribution expressed in their trivial names;"131 and different species of bears thrive in tropical, temperate, and arctic latitudes.

When thinking about these phenomena, the reader should always remember that the fossil specimens were from species of elephant, rhinoceros, hippopotamus, bear, tiger, and hyena, which are different from those that currently live in or near the tropics. Dr. Fleming, in discussing this topic, pointed out that a close similarity in shape and bone structure doesn't always mean that these species have similar geographical ranges in the present day. Therefore, we need to be cautious about making confident conclusions based solely on anatomical similarities regarding the behaviors and unique characteristics of species that no longer exist. "The zebra enjoys roaming the tropical plains, while the horse can survive the harsh winters of Iceland. Like the zebra, the buffalo prefers warmer temperatures and can't thrive where the common cow does well. In contrast, the musk-ox, which closely resembles the buffalo, prefers the sparse vegetation of the Arctic and is able to survive northern winters through its seasonal migrations. The jackal (Canis aureus) lives in Africa, warmer parts of Asia, and Greece, while the isatis (Canis lagopus) inhabits the Arctic regions. The African hare and polar hare are named after their geographical ranges; and different bear species thrive in tropical, temperate, and Arctic regions."

Recent investigations have placed beyond all doubt the important fact that a species of tiger, identical with that of Bengal, is common in the neighborhood of Lake Aral, near Sussac, in the forty-fifth degree of north latitude; and from time to time this animal is now seen in Siberia, in a latitude as far north as the parallel of Berlin and Hamburgh.132 Humboldt remarks that the part of Southern Asia now inhabited by this Indian species of tiger is separated from the Himalaya by two great chains of mountains, each covered with perpetual snow,—the chain of Kuenlun, lat. 35° N., and that of Mouztagh, lat. 42°,—so that it is impossible that these animals should merely have made excursions from India, so as to have penetrated in summer to the forty-eighth and fifty-third degrees of north latitude. They must remain all the winter north of the Mouztagh, or Celestial Mountains. The last tiger killed, in 1828, on the Lena, in lat. 52-1/4°, was in a climate colder than that of Petersburg and Stockholm.133

Recent investigations have clearly shown that a species of tiger, the same as the one found in Bengal, is common around Lake Aral near Sussac, at the 45th degree of north latitude. From time to time, this animal is now spotted in Siberia, reaching as far north as the latitude of Berlin and Hamburg.132 Humboldt points out that the part of Southern Asia currently inhabited by this Indian tiger species is separated from the Himalayas by two major mountain ranges, each covered in permanent snow—the Kuenlun range at 35° N latitude and the Mouztagh range at 42° N latitude. This makes it unlikely that these animals simply traveled from India to the higher latitudes in summer. They must remain north of the Mouztagh, or the Celestial Mountains, throughout the winter. The last tiger killed in 1828 on the Lena, at 52-1/4° latitude, was in a climate colder than that of Petersburg and Stockholm.133

We learn from Mr. Hodgson's account of the mammalia of Nepal, that the tiger is sometimes found at the very edge of perpetual snow in the Himalaya;134 and Pennant mentions that it is found among the snows of Mount Ararat in Armenia. The jaguar, also, has been seen in America, wandering from Mexico, as far north as Kentucky, lat. 37° N.,135 and even as far as 42° S. in South America,—a latitude which corresponds to that of the Pyrenees in the northern hemisphere.136 The range of the puma is still wider, for it roams from the equator to the Straits of Magellan, being often seen at Port Famine, in lat. 53° 38' S.

We learn from Mr. Hodgson's account of the mammals in Nepal that tigers are sometimes found right at the edge of permanent snow in the Himalayas;134 and Pennant notes that they can also be found among the snows of Mount Ararat in Armenia. Jaguars have been spotted in America, traveling from Mexico all the way up to Kentucky, at latitude 37° N.,135 and even as far south as 42° S. in South America— a latitude that matches that of the Pyrenees in the northern hemisphere.136 The range of pumas is even broader, as they roam from the equator to the Straits of Magellan, often seen at Port Famine, at latitude 53° 38' S.

A new species of panther (Felis irbis), covered with long hair, has been discovered in Siberia, evidently inhabiting, like the tiger, a region north of the Celestial Mountains, which are in lat. 42°.137

A new species of panther (Felis irbis), with long fur, has been found in Siberia, clearly living, like the tiger, in a region north of the Celestial Mountains, located at lat. 42°.137

The two-horned African rhinoceros occurs without the tropics at the Cape of Good Hope, in lat. 34° 29' S., where it is accompanied by the elephant, hippopotamus, and hyæna. Here the migration of all these species towards the south is arrested by the ocean; but if the continent had been prolonged still farther, and the land had been of moderate elevation, 78 it is very probable that they might have extended their range to a greater distance from the tropics.

The two-horned African rhinoceros is found outside the tropics at the Cape of Good Hope, located at 34° 29' S., where it shares its habitat with elephants, hippopotamuses, and hyenas. Here, the migration of all these species southward is stopped by the ocean; however, if the continent had continued further and the land had been at a moderate height, 78 it's very likely they could have spread out further from the tropics.

Now, if the Indian tiger can range in our own times to the southern borders of Siberia, or skirt the snows of the Himalaya, and if the puma can reach the fifty-third degree of latitude in South America, we may easily understand how large species of the same genera may once have inhabited our temperate climates. The mammoth (E. primigenius), already alluded to, as occurring fossil in England, was decidedly different from the two existing species of elephants, one of which is limited to Asia, south of the 31° of N. lat., the other to Africa, where it extends, as before stated, as far south as the Cape of Good Hope. The bones of the great fossil species are very widely spread over Europe and North America; but are nowhere in such profusion as in Siberia, particularly near the shores of the Frozen Ocean. Are we, then, to conclude that this animal preferred a polar climate? If so, it may well be asked, by what food was it sustained, and why does it not still survive near the arctic circle?138

Now, if the Indian tiger can roam in our times up to the southern borders of Siberia, or along the snowy Himalayas, and if the puma can reach the fifty-third degree of latitude in South America, we can easily see how large species of the same genera may have once lived in our temperate climates. The mammoth (E. primigenius), which has already been mentioned as a fossil found in England, was clearly different from the two existing species of elephants, one of which is found in Asia, south of 31° N latitude, while the other is in Africa, extending, as mentioned before, as far south as the Cape of Good Hope. The bones of this great fossil species are found all over Europe and North America, but they are most abundant in Siberia, especially near the shores of the Frozen Ocean. Are we to conclude that this animal preferred a polar climate? If so, we should ask, what did it eat, and why doesn’t it still exist near the Arctic Circle?138

Pallas and other writers describe the bones of the mammoth as abounding throughout all the Lowlands of Siberia, stretching in a direction west and east, from the borders of Europe to the extreme point nearest America, and south and north, from the base of the mountains of Central Asia to the shores of the Arctic Sea. (See map, fig. 1.) Within this space, scarcely inferior in area to the whole of Europe, fossil ivory has been collected almost everywhere, on the banks of the Irtish, Obi, Yenesei, Lena, and other rivers. The elephantine remains do not occur in the marshes and low plains, but where the banks of the rivers present lofty precipices of sand and clay, from which circumstance Pallas very justly inferred that, if sections could be obtained, similar bones might be found in all the elevated lands intervening between the great rivers. Strahlenberg, indeed, had stated, before the time of Pallas, that wherever any of the great rivers overflowed and cut out fresh channels during floods, more fossil remains of the same kind were invariably disclosed.

Pallas and other writers describe mammoth bones as being spread throughout all the Lowlands of Siberia, stretching west to east from the borders of Europe to the furthest point closest to America, and north to south from the base of the Central Asian mountains to the shores of the Arctic Sea. (See map, fig. 1.) Within this area, which is nearly the same size as all of Europe, fossil ivory has been found almost everywhere along the banks of the Irtish, Obi, Yenesei, Lena, and other rivers. The elephant remains are not found in the marshes and low plains, but where the riverbanks have steep cliffs of sand and clay. From this, Pallas rightly concluded that if cross-sections were taken, similar bones might also be found in all the elevated lands between the major rivers. Strahlenberg had already noted before Pallas that whenever the major rivers flooded and created new channels, more fossil remains of the same kind were consistently revealed.

Siberia Map.Map Of Siberia.

Fig. 1. Map showing the course of the Siberian rivers from south to north, from temperate to arctic regions, in the country where the fossil bones of the Mammoth abound.

Fig. 1. Map showing the route of the Siberian rivers from south to north, transitioning from temperate to arctic areas, in the country where fossilized Mammoth bones are plentiful.

As to the position of the bones, Pallas found them in some places imbedded together with marine remains; in others, simply with fossil wood, or lignite, such as, he says, might have been derived from carbonized peat. On the banks of the Yenesei, below the city of Krasnojarsk, in lat. 56°, he observed grinders, and bones of elephants, in strata of yellow 79 and red loam, alternating with coarse sand and gravel, in which was also much petrified wood of the willow and other trees. Neither here nor in the neighboring country were there any marine shells, but merely layers of black coal.139 But grinders of the mammoth were collected much farther down the same river, near the sea, in lat. 70°, mixed with marine petrifactions.140 Many other places in Siberia are cited by Pallas, 80 where sea shells and fishes' teeth accompany the bones of the mammoth, rhinoceros, and Siberian buffalo, or bison (Bos priscus). But it is not on the Obi nor the Yenesei, but on the Lena, farther to the east, where, in the same parallels of latitude, the cold is far more intense, that fossil remains have been found in the most wonderful state of preservation. In 1772, Pallas obtained from Wiljuiskoi, in lat. 64°, from the banks of the Wiljui, a tributary of the Lena, the carcass of a rhinoceros (R. tichorhinus), taken from the sand in which it must have remained congealed for ages, the soil of that region being always frozen to within a slight depth of the surface. This carcass was compared to a natural mummy, and emitted an odor like putrid flesh, part of the skin being still covered with black and gray hairs. So great, indeed, was the quantity of hair on the foot and head conveyed to St. Petersburg, that Pallas asked whether the rhinoceros of the Lena might not have been an inhabitant of the temperate regions of middle Asia, its clothing being so much warmer than that of the African rhinoceros.141

As for the position of the bones, Pallas found them in some places mixed with marine remains; in others, simply with fossilized wood or lignite, which, he says, might have come from carbonized peat. On the banks of the Yenesei, below the city of Krasnojarsk, at latitude 56°, he observed teeth and bones of elephants in layers of yellow and red loam, alternating with coarse sand and gravel, which also contained a lot of petrified wood from willows and other trees. Neither here nor in the surrounding area were there any marine shells, just layers of black coal.139 But mammoth teeth were found much farther down the same river, near the sea, at latitude 70°, mixed with marine fossils.140 Many other locations in Siberia are mentioned by Pallas, 80 where sea shells and fish teeth are found alongside bones of the mammoth, rhinoceros, and Siberian buffalo or bison (Bos priscus). However, it is not on the Obi or the Yenesei, but on the Lena, further to the east, where, at the same latitudes, the cold is much harsher, that fossil remains have been found in remarkable condition. In 1772, Pallas obtained from Wiljuiskoi, at latitude 64°, from the banks of the Wiljui, a tributary of the Lena, the carcass of a rhinoceros (R. tichorhinus) that had been taken from the sand where it must have been frozen for ages, as the soil in that area is always frozen just below the surface. This carcass was compared to a natural mummy and gave off an odor similar to rotting flesh, with part of the skin still covered in black and gray hairs. In fact, the amount of hair on the foot and head sent to St. Petersburg was so great that Pallas wondered whether the rhinoceros of the Lena might have lived in the temperate regions of Central Asia, as its fur was much thicker than that of the African rhinoceros.141

Professor Brandt, of St. Petersburg, in a letter to Baron Alex. Von Humboldt, dated 1846, adds the following particulars respecting this wonderful fossil relic:—"I have been so fortunate as to extract from cavities in the molar teeth of the Wiljui rhinoceros a small quantity of its half-chewed food, among which fragments of pine leaves, one-half of the seed of a polygonaceous plant, and very minute portions of wood with porous cells (or small fragments of coniferous wood), were still recognizable. It was also remarkable, on a close investigation of the head, that the blood-vessels discovered in the interior of the mass appeared filled, even to the capillary vessels, with a brown mass (coagulated blood), which in many places still showed the red color of blood."142

Professor Brandt from St. Petersburg mentioned in a letter to Baron Alex. Von Humboldt, dated 1846, the following details about this amazing fossil:—"I was fortunate to extract a small amount of half-chewed food from the molar teeth of the Wiljui rhinoceros. Among this food were fragments of pine leaves, half a seed from a polygonaceous plant, and tiny pieces of wood with porous cells (or small bits of coniferous wood). It was also notable that upon closely examining the head, the blood vessels found inside the mass seemed to be filled, even down to the capillaries, with a brown substance (coagulated blood), which in many areas still displayed the red color of blood."142

After more than thirty years, the entire carcass of a mammoth (or extinct species of elephant) was obtained in 1803, by Mr. Adams, much farther to the north. It fell from a mass of ice, in which it had been encased, on the banks of the Lena, in lat. 70°; and so perfectly had the soft parts of the carcass been preserved, that the flesh, as it lay, was devoured by wolves and bears. This skeleton is still in the museum of St. Petersburg, the head retaining its integument and many of the ligaments entire. The skin of the animal was covered, first, with black bristles, thicker than horse hair, from twelve to sixteen inches in length; secondly, with hair of a reddish brown color, about four inches long; and thirdly, with wool of the same color as the hair, about an inch in length. Of the fur, upwards of thirty pounds' weight were gathered from the wet sand-bank. The individual was nine feet high and sixteen feet long, without reckoning the large curved tusks: a size rarely surpassed by the largest living male elephants.143

After more than thirty years, Mr. Adams acquired the complete carcass of a mammoth (or an extinct species of elephant) in 1803, much farther north. It had fallen from a mass of ice, in which it had been trapped, on the banks of the Lena River, at latitude 70°. The soft tissues of the carcass were so well-preserved that wolves and bears were able to eat the flesh as it lay. This skeleton is still in the museum in St. Petersburg, with the head still covered in skin and many ligaments intact. The animal's skin was first covered in black bristles, thicker than horsehair, ranging from twelve to sixteen inches long; second, with reddish-brown hair, about four inches long; and third, with wool of the same color as the hair, about an inch long. Over thirty pounds of fur were collected from the wet sandbank. The mammoth stood nine feet tall and measured sixteen feet long, not including the large curved tusks—a size rarely surpassed by the largest living male elephants.143

It is evident, then, that the mammoth, instead of being naked, like the 81living Indian and African elephants, was enveloped in a thick shaggy covering of fur, probably as impenetrable to rain and cold as that of the musk ox.144 The species may have been fitted by nature to withstand the vicissitudes of a northern climate; and it is certain that, from the moment when the carcasses, both of the rhinoceros and elephant, above described, were buried in Siberia, in latitudes 64° and 70° N., the soil must have remained frozen, and the atmosphere nearly as cold as at this day.

It’s clear, then, that the mammoth, instead of being bare like the living Indian and African elephants, was covered in a thick, shaggy layer of fur, likely just as protective against rain and cold as that of the musk ox.144 This species may have been naturally equipped to handle the challenges of a northern climate; and it’s certain that from the moment the carcasses of both the rhinoceros and elephant, as described above, were buried in Siberia, at latitudes 64° and 70° N., the ground must have stayed frozen, and the air nearly as cold as it is today.

The most recent discoveries made in 1843 by Mr. Middendorf, a distinguished Russian naturalist, and which he communicated to me in September, 1846, afford more precise information as to the climate of the Siberian lowlands, at the period when the extinct quadrupeds were entombed. One elephant was found on the Tas, between the Obi and Yenesei, near the arctic circle, about lat. 66° 30' N., with some parts of the flesh in so perfect a state that the bulb of the eye is now preserved in the museum at Moscow. Another carcass, together with a young individual of the same species, was met with in the same year, 1843, in lat. 75° 15' N., near the river Taimyr, with the flesh decayed. It was imbedded in strata of clay and sand, with erratic blocks, at about 15 feet above the level of the sea. In the same deposit Mr. Middendorf observed the trunk of a larch tree (Pinus larix), the same wood as that now carried down in abundance by the Taimyr to the Arctic Sea. There were also associated fossil shells of living northern species, and which are moreover characteristic of the drift or glacial deposits of Europe. Among these Nucula pygmæa, Tellina calcarea, Mya truncata, and Saxicava rugosa were conspicuous.

The latest discoveries made in 1843 by Mr. Middendorf, a notable Russian naturalist, which he shared with me in September 1846, provide more accurate information about the climate of the Siberian lowlands during the time when the extinct mammals were buried. One elephant was found on the Tas River, between the Obi and Yenesei, near the Arctic Circle, at about 66° 30' N latitude, with some parts of the flesh in such good condition that the eye bulb is now displayed in a museum in Moscow. Another carcass, along with a juvenile of the same species, was discovered in the same year, 1843, at 75° 15' N latitude, near the Taimyr River, though its flesh had decayed. It was embedded in layers of clay and sand, with erratic blocks, around 15 feet above sea level. In the same site, Mr. Middendorf noted the trunk of a larch tree (Pinus larix), the same type of wood that is now carried down in abundance by the Taimyr to the Arctic Sea. There were also fossil shells of living northern species found, characteristic of the drift or glacial deposits of Europe. Among these, Nucula pygmæa, Tellina calcarea, Mya truncata, and Saxicava rugosa were notable.

So fresh is the ivory throughout northern Russia, that, according to Tilesius, thousands of fossil tusks have been collected and used in turning; yet others are still procured and sold in great plenty. He declares his belief that the bones still left in northern Russia must greatly exceed in number all the elephants now living on the globe.

So abundant is the ivory throughout northern Russia that, according to Tilesius, thousands of fossil tusks have been gathered and used in crafting; many more are still being sourced and sold in large quantities. He expresses his belief that the bones still remaining in northern Russia must far outnumber all the elephants currently living on the planet.

We are as yet ignorant of the entire geographical range of the mammoth; but its remains have been recently collected from the cliffs of frozen mud and ice on the east side of Behring's Straits, in Eschscholtz's Bay, in Russian America, lat. 66° N. As the cliffs waste away by the thawing of the ice, tusks and bones fall out, and a strong odor of animal matter is exhaled from the mud.145

We still don't know the full geographical range of the mammoth, but its remains have recently been found in the cliffs of frozen mud and ice on the eastern side of Bering Straits, in Eschscholtz Bay, Russian America, at lat. 66° N. As the cliffs erode due to the melting ice, tusks and bones drop out, and a strong smell of decaying animal matter wafts up from the mud.145

On considering all the facts above enumerated, it seems reasonable to imagine that a large region in central Asia, including, perhaps, the southern half of Siberia, enjoyed, at no very remote period in the earth's history, a temperate climate, sufficiently mild to afford food for numerous herds of elephants and rhinoceroses, of species distinct from those now living. It has usually been taken for granted that herbivorous animals of large size require a very luxuriant vegetation for their support; but this opinion is, according to Mr. Darwin, completely erroneous:—"It has been derived," he says, "from our acquaintance with India and the Indian islands, where the mind has been accustomed to associate troops of elephants with noble forests and impenetrable jungles. But the southern parts of Africa, from the tropic of Capricorn to the Cape of Good Hope, although sterile and desert, are remarkable for the number and great bulk of the indigenous quadrupeds. We there meet with an elephant, five species of rhinoceros, a hippopotamus, a giraffe, the bos caffer, the elan, two zebras, the quagga, two gnus, and several antelopes. Nor must we suppose, that while the species are numerous, the individuals of each kind are few. Dr. Andrew Smith saw, in one day's march, in lat. 24° S., without wandering to any great distance on either side, about 150 rhinoceroses, with several herds of giraffes, and his party had killed, on the previous night, eight hippopotamuses. Yet the country which they inhabited was thinly covered with grass and bushes about four feet high, and still more thinly with mimosa-trees, so that the wagons of the travellers were not prevented from proceeding in a nearly direct line."146

Considering all the facts mentioned above, it seems reasonable to think that a large area in central Asia, possibly including the southern half of Siberia, had a temperate climate not too long ago in Earth’s history, one mild enough to support large populations of elephants and rhinoceroses, of species different from those currently living. It's generally assumed that large herbivorous animals need very lush vegetation to survive; however, according to Mr. Darwin, this idea is completely wrong:—"It has been derived," he states, "from our experience with India and the Indian islands, where people often associate groups of elephants with grand forests and dense jungles. But the southern parts of Africa, from the tropic of Capricorn to the Cape of Good Hope, despite being barren and desert-like, are notable for the number and size of native mammals. There, we find an elephant, five species of rhinoceros, a hippopotamus, a giraffe, the bos caffer, the elan, two zebras, the quagga, two gnus, and several antelopes. And we shouldn’t think that while the species are numerous, the number of individuals of each kind is low. Dr. Andrew Smith observed about 150 rhinoceroses in a single day’s march at latitude 24° S., without straying far to either side, along with several herds of giraffes, and his group had killed eight hippopotamuses the previous night. Yet, the area they inhabited was only sparsely covered with grass and bushes about four feet tall, and even more sparsely with mimosa trees, allowing the travelers’ wagons to travel nearly in a straight line."146

In order to explain how so many animals can find support in this region, it is suggested that the underwood, of which their food chiefly consists, may contain much nutriment in a small bulk, and also that the vegetation has a rapid growth; for no sooner is a part consumed than its place, says Dr. Smith, is supplied by a fresh stock. Nevertheless, after making every allowance for this successive production and consumption, it is clear, from the facts above cited, that the quantity of food required by the larger herbivora is much less than we have usually imagined. Mr. Darwin conceives that the amount of vegetation supported at any one time by Great Britain may exceed, in a ten-fold ratio, the quantity existing on an equal area in the interior parts of Southern Africa.147 It is remarked, moreover, in illustration of the small connec83tion discoverable between abundance of food and the magnitude of indigenous mammalia, that while in the desert part of Southern Africa there are so many huge animals; in Brazil, where the splendor and exuberance of the vegetation are unrivalled, there is not a single wild quadruped of large size.148

To explain how so many animals can thrive in this area, it's suggested that the underbrush, which mainly constitutes their food, may be rich in nutrients despite its small size, and that the plants grow quickly; as soon as one part is eaten, a new one takes its place, according to Dr. Smith. However, even considering this continuous cycle of growth and consumption, it's clear from the facts mentioned that the amount of food needed by larger herbivores is much less than we typically thought. Mr. Darwin believes that the amount of vegetation supported at any given time by Great Britain could be ten times greater than that found on an equal area in the interior regions of Southern Africa.147 Additionally, it's noted as an example of the weak connection between food abundance and the size of native mammals that while the desert regions of Southern Africa are home to many large animals, in Brazil, where the vegetation is stunning and plentiful, there isn’t a single large wild mammal.148

It would doubtless be impossible for herds of mammoths and rhinoceroses to subsist, at present, throughout the year, even in the southern part of Siberia, covered as it is with snow during winter; but there is no difficulty in supposing a vegetation capable of nourishing these great quadrupeds to have once flourished between the latitudes 40° and 60° N.

It would definitely be impossible for herds of mammoths and rhinoceroses to survive all year round today, even in the southern part of Siberia, which is covered in snow during winter; however, it's not hard to imagine that a type of vegetation capable of supporting these large animals could have once thrived between the latitudes of 40° and 60° N.

Dr. Fleming has hinted, that "the kind of food which the existing species of elephant prefers, will not enable us to determine, or even to offer a probable conjecture, concerning that of the extinct species. No one acquainted with the gramineous character of the food of our fallow-deer, stag, or roe, would have assigned a lichen to the reindeer."

Dr. Fleming has suggested that "the type of food that the current species of elephant prefers won't help us figure out, or even make an educated guess about, the diet of the extinct species. Anyone familiar with the grass-based diet of our fallow deer, stag, or roe deer wouldn't have thought to classify lichen as food for the reindeer."

Travellers mention that, even now, when the climate of eastern Asia is so much colder than the same parallels of latitude farther west, there are woods not only of fir, but of birch, poplar, and alder, on the banks of the Lena, as far north as latitude 60°.

Travellers note that even today, when the climate in eastern Asia is much colder than at the same latitudes further west, there are forests not just of fir, but also of birch, poplar, and alder along the banks of the Lena, as far north as latitude 60°.

It has, moreover, been suggested, that as, in our own times, the northern animals migrate, so the Siberian elephant and rhinoceros may have wandered towards the north in summer. The musk oxen annually desert their winter quarters in the south, and cross the sea upon the ice, to graze for four months, from May to September, on the rich pasturage of Melville Island, in lat. 75°. The mammoths, without passing so far beyond the arctic circle, may nevertheless have made excursions, during the heat of a brief northern summer, from the central or temperate parts of Asia to the sixtieth parallel of latitude.

It has also been suggested that just like northern animals migrate today, the Siberian elephant and rhinoceros may have moved north in the summer. The musk oxen leave their southern winter homes each year and travel across the ice to graze for four months, from May to September, on the rich pastures of Melville Island, at latitude 75°. The mammoths, while not going as far past the Arctic Circle, might have made trips during the short northern summer from the central or temperate regions of Asia to approximately the sixtieth parallel of latitude.

Now, in this case, the preservation of their bones, or even occasionally of their entire carcasses, in ice or frozen soil, may be accounted for, without resorting to speculations concerning sudden revolutions in the former state and climate of the earth's surface. We are entitled to assume, that, in the time of the extinct elephant and rhinoceros, the Lowland of Siberia was less extensive towards the north than now; for we have seen (p. 80) that the strata of this Lowland, in which the fossil bones lie buried, were originally deposited beneath the sea; and we know, from the facts brought to light in Wrangle's Voyage, in the years 1821, 1822, and 1823, that a slow upheaval of the land along the borders of the Icy Sea is now constantly taking place, similar to that experienced in part of Sweden. In the same manner, then, as the shores of the Gulf of Bothnia are extended, not only by the influx of sediment brought down by rivers, but also by the elevation and consequent drying up of the bed of the sea, so a like combination of causes may, in modern times, have been extending the low tract of land where marine 84shells and fossil bones occur in Siberia.149 Such a change in the physical geography of that region, implying a constant augmentation in the quantity of arctic land, would, according to principles to be explained in the next chapter, tend to increase the severity of the winters. We may conclude, therefore, that, before the land reached so far to the north, the temperature of the Siberian winter and summer was more nearly equalized; and a greater degree of winter's cold may, even more than a general diminution of the mean annual temperature, have finally contributed to the extermination of the mammoth and its contemporaries.

Now, in this case, the preservation of their bones, or even sometimes their entire bodies, in ice or frozen ground can be explained without having to speculate about sudden changes in the earth's surface and climate. We can assume that during the time of the extinct elephant and rhinoceros, the Lowland of Siberia extended less to the north than it does now; as we've noted (p. 80), the layers of this Lowland, where the fossil bones are buried, were originally deposited underwater. We know from findings from Wrangel's Voyage in 1821, 1822, and 1823 that there has been a gradual uplift of land along the shores of the Arctic Sea, similar to what has occurred in parts of Sweden. Just as the shores of the Gulf of Bothnia are expanded not only by the sediment brought down by rivers but also by the rising and drying up of the seabed, it’s likely that a combination of similar factors has been extending the low land where sea shells and fossil bones are found in Siberia.84 Such changes in the physical geography of that region, reflecting a steady increase in arctic land, would, according to principles we’ll discuss in the next chapter, tend to make winters harsher. Therefore, we can conclude that before the land extended so far north, the temperatures of Siberian winters and summers were more balanced; and an increase in winter cold, more than a general decrease in annual average temperatures, may have played a significant role in the extinction of the mammoth and its contemporaries.

On referring to the map (p. 79), the reader will see how all the great rivers of Siberia flow at present from south to north, from temperate to arctic regions, and they are all liable, like the Mackenzie, in North America, to remarkable floods, in consequence of flowing in this direction. For they are filled with running water in their upper or southern course when completely frozen over for several hundred miles near their mouths, where they remain blocked up by ice for six months in every year. The descending waters, therefore, finding no open channel, rush over the ice, often changing their direction, and sweeping along forests and prodigious quantities of soil and gravel mixed with ice. Now the rivers of Siberia are among the largest in the world, the Yenesei having a course of 2500, the Lena of 2000 miles; so that we may easily conceive that the bodies of animals which fall into their waters may be transported to vast distances towards the Arctic Sea, and, before arriving there, may be stranded upon and often frozen into thick ice. Afterwards, when the ice breaks up, they may be floated still farther towards the ocean, until at length they become buried in fluviatile and submarine deposits near the mouths of rivers.

On looking at the map (p. 79), you'll notice how all the major rivers in Siberia currently flow from south to north, moving from temperate to arctic areas. Like the Mackenzie River in North America, they are prone to significant floods due to this flow direction. In their upper or southern sections, they contain flowing water even when completely frozen over for hundreds of miles near their mouths, where they stay blocked by ice for six months each year. As the water descends, it has no open channels, so it rushes over the ice, often changing direction and carrying away trees and huge amounts of soil and gravel mixed with ice. The rivers in Siberia are among the largest in the world, with the Yenisei running for 2,500 miles and the Lena for 2,000 miles. Therefore, it's easy to imagine that the bodies of animals falling into these rivers can be carried over great distances toward the Arctic Sea and, before reaching it, can be stranded and often frozen into thick ice. Later, when the ice breaks up, they can be carried even farther toward the ocean until they eventually get buried in river and sea deposits near the river mouths.

Humboldt remarks that near the mouths of the Lena a considerable thickness of frozen soil may be found at all seasons at the depth of a few feet; so that if a carcass be once imbedded in mud and ice in such a region and in such a climate, its putrefaction may be arrested for indefinite ages.150 According to Prof. Von Baer of St. Petersburg, the ground is now frozen permanently to the depth of 400 feet, at the town of Yakutzt, on the western bank of the Lena, in lat. 62° N., 600 miles distant from the polar sea. Mr. Hedenstrom tells us that, throughout a wide area in Siberia, the boundary cliffs of the lakes and rivers consist of alternate layers of earthy materials and ice, in horizontal stratification;151 and Mr. Middendorf informed us, in 1846, that, in his tour there three years before, he had bored in Siberia to the depth of seventy feet, and, after passing through much frozen soil mixed with ice, had come 85down upon a solid mass of pure transparent ice, the thickness of which, after penetrating two or three yards, they did not ascertain. We may conceive, therefore, that even at the period of the mammoth, when the Lowland of Siberia was less extensive towards the north, and consequently the climate more temperate than now, the cold may still have been sufficiently intense to cause the rivers flowing in their present direction to sweep down from south to north the bodies of drowned animals, and there bury them in drift ice and frozen mud.

Humboldt notes that near the mouths of the Lena River, you can find a significant layer of frozen soil all year round at just a few feet deep; so if a carcass gets trapped in mud and ice in such a region and climate, it can stop decaying for endless ages.150 According to Prof. Von Baer from St. Petersburg, the ground is permanently frozen to a depth of 400 feet in the town of Yakutsk, located on the western bank of the Lena, at latitude 62° N, which is 600 miles away from the Arctic Ocean. Mr. Hedenstrom tells us that, over a large area in Siberia, the cliffs along the edges of lakes and rivers consist of alternating layers of earth and ice, laid out horizontally;151 and Mr. Middendorf reported in 1846 that during his trip there three years earlier, he drilled down in Siberia to a depth of seventy feet, and after going through a lot of frozen soil mixed with ice, he hit a solid mass of pure transparent ice, the thickness of which, after going in two or three yards, they couldn't determine. We can imagine, then, that even during the time of the mammoth, when Siberia's lowlands extended less far north and the climate was milder than today, the cold might still have been intense enough to carry the bodies of drowned animals, flowing in the current, south to north, and bury them in drift ice and frozen mud.

If it be true that the carcass of the mammoth was imbedded in pure ice, there are two ways in which it may have been frozen in. We may suppose the animal to have been overwhelmed by drift snow. I have been informed by Dr. Richardson, that, in the northern parts of America, comprising regions now inhabited by many herbivorous quadrupeds, the drift snow is often converted into permanent glaciers. It is commonly blown over the edges of steep cliffs, so as to form an inclined talus hundreds of feet high; and when a thaw commences, torrents rush from the land, and throw down from the top of the cliff alluvial soil and gravel. This new soil soon becomes covered with vegetation, and protects the foundation of snow from the rays of the sun. Water occasionally penetrates into the crevices and pores of the snow; but, as it soon freezes again, it serves the more rapidly to consolidate the mass into a compact iceberg. It may sometimes happen that cattle grazing in a valley at the base of such cliffs, on the borders of a sea or river, may be overwhelmed, and at length inclosed in solid ice, and then transported towards the polar regions. Or a herd of mammoths returning from their summer pastures in the north, may have been surprised, while crossing a stream, by the sudden congelation of the waters. The missionary Huc relates, in his travels in Thibet in 1846, that, after many of his party had been frozen to death, they pitched their tents on the banks of the Mouroui-Ousson (which lower down becomes the famous Blue River), and saw from their encampment "some black shapeless objects ranged in file across the stream. As they advanced nearer no change either in form or distinctness was apparent; nor was it till they were quite close, that they recognized in them a troop of the wild oxen, called Yak by the Thibetans.152 There were more than fifty of them incrusted in the ice. No doubt they had tried to swim across at the moment of congelation, and had been unable to disengage themselves. Their beautiful heads, surmounted by huge horns, were still above the surface, but their bodies were held fast in the ice, which was so transparent that the position of the imprudent beasts was easily distinguishable; they looked as if still swimming, but the eagles and ravens had pecked out their eyes."153

If it's true that the mammoth's body was trapped in pure ice, there are two ways it could have been frozen. One possibility is that the animal was buried under drifting snow. Dr. Richardson informed me that in the northern parts of America, areas now home to many herbivorous mammals, the drifting snow often turns into permanent glaciers. It's typically blown over the edges of steep cliffs, forming a sloped pile hundreds of feet high. When a thaw begins, torrents flow down from the land, washing away alluvial soil and gravel from the top of the cliff. This new soil quickly gets covered with vegetation, shielding the snow underneath from sunlight. Water occasionally seeps into the cracks and pores of the snow; when it freezes again soon after, it helps to solidify the mass into a compact iceberg. Sometimes, cattle grazing in a valley at the base of such cliffs, near a sea or river, may be buried and eventually trapped in solid ice, only to be carried toward the polar regions. Alternatively, a herd of mammoths returning from their summer grazing in the north could have been caught off guard while crossing a stream by the sudden freezing of the water. The missionary Huc recounts in his travels in Tibet in 1846 that after many in his party froze to death, they set up camp on the banks of the Mouroui-Ousson (which further down becomes the well-known Blue River) and saw from their camp "some black, shapeless forms lined up across the stream. As they got closer, there was no change in shape or clarity; only when they were right up against them did they recognize a herd of the wild oxen, called Yak by the Tibetans.152 There were more than fifty of them trapped in the ice. No doubt they had tried to swim across at the moment of freezing and couldn't pull themselves free. Their beautiful heads, with massive horns, were still above the surface, but their bodies were stuck in the ice, which was so clear that you could easily see the position of the unfortunate animals; they looked like they were still swimming, but the eagles and ravens had pecked out their eyes."153

The foregoing investigations, therefore, lead us to infer that the mammoth, and some other extinct quadrupeds fitted to live in high latitudes, 86were inhabitants of Northern Asia at a time when the geographical conditions and climate of that continent were different from the present. But the age of this fauna was comparatively modern in the earth's history. It appears that when the oldest or eocene tertiary deposits were formed, a warm temperature pervaded the European seas and lands. Shells of the genus Nautilus and other forms characteristic of tropical latitudes; fossil reptiles, such as the crocodile, turtle, and tortoise; plants, such as palms, some of them allied to the cocoa-nut, the screw-pine, the custard-apple, and the acacia, all lead to this conclusion. This flora and fauna were followed by those of the miocene formation, in which indications of a southern, but less tropical climate are detected. Finally, the pliocene deposits, which come next in succession, exhibit in their organic remains a much nearer approach to the state of things now prevailing in corresponding latitudes. It was towards the close of this period that the seas of the northern hemisphere became more and more filled with floating icebergs often charged with erratic blocks, so that the waters and the atmosphere were chilled by the melting ice, and an arctic fauna enabled, for a time, to invade the temperate latitudes both of N. America and Europe. The extinction of a considerable number of land quadrupeds and aquatic mollusca was gradually brought about by the increasing severity of the cold; but many species survived this revolution in climate, either by their capacity of living under a variety of conditions, or by migrating for a time to more southern lands and seas. At length, by modifications in the physical geography of the northern regions, and the cessation of floating ice on the eastern side of the Atlantic, the cold was moderated, and a milder climate ensued, such as we now enjoy in Europe.154

The previous investigations lead us to conclude that the mammoth and some other extinct mammals adapted to live in colder regions were residents of Northern Asia at a time when the geography and climate of that continent were different from today. However, this fauna existed relatively recently in the Earth's history. It seems that when the oldest or Eocene tertiary deposits were formed, a warm climate spread across the European seas and lands. Fossils of the genus Nautilus and other species typical of tropical regions, as well as fossil reptiles like crocodiles, turtles, and tortoises, and plants such as palms related to coconuts, screw pines, custard apples, and acacias, all support this idea. This flora and fauna were succeeded by the Miocene formation, which shows signs of a southern, but less tropical climate. Lastly, the Pliocene deposits that follow exhibit organic remains much more similar to the current conditions in those latitudes. Toward the end of this period, the seas in the northern hemisphere became increasingly filled with floating icebergs often carrying erratic blocks, chilling the waters and atmosphere from the melting ice. This allowed an Arctic fauna to invade the temperate regions of North America and Europe for a time. The extinction of a significant number of land mammals and aquatic mollusks happened gradually due to the growing severity of the cold, but many species survived this climatic upheaval, either by adapting to different conditions or by temporarily migrating to warmer lands and seas. Eventually, due to changes in the physical geography of the northern areas and the end of floating ice on the eastern side of the Atlantic, the cold eased, leading to a milder climate like the one we enjoy in Europe now.

Proofs from fossils in secondary and still older strata.—A great interval of time appears to have elapsed between the formation of the secondary strata, which constitute the principal portion of the elevated land in Europe, and the origin of the eocene deposits. If we examine the rocks from the chalk to the new red sandstone inclusive, we find many distinct assemblages of fossils entombed in them, all of unknown species, and many of them referable to genera and families now most abundant between the tropics. Among the most remarkable are reptiles of gigantic size; some of them herbivorous, others carnivorous, and far exceeding in size any now known even in the torrid zone. The genera are for the most part extinct, but some of them, as the crocodile and monitor, have still representatives in the warmer parts of the earth. Coral reefs also were evidently numerous in the seas of the same periods, composed of species often belonging to genera now characteristic of a tropical climate. The number of large chambered shells 87also, including the nautilus, leads us to infer an elevated temperature; and the associated fossil plants, although imperfectly known, tend to the same conclusion, the Cycadeæ constituting the most numerous family.

Fossil Evidence from Older Layers.—A substantial amount of time seems to have passed between the formation of the secondary layers, which make up most of the elevated land in Europe, and the beginning of the eocene deposits. When we look at the rocks ranging from chalk to new red sandstone, we discover many different groups of fossils embedded in them, all of unknown species, with many belonging to genera and families that are currently most prevalent in tropical regions. Among the most impressive are enormous reptiles; some were herbivores, others were carnivores, and they were much larger than any currently known, even in hot climates. Most of the genera are extinct, but a few, like crocodiles and monitors, still exist in warmer parts of the world. Coral reefs were also clearly abundant in the seas during these periods, made up of species that often belong to genera typical of tropical climates. The presence of large chambered shells, including the nautilus, suggests a warmer temperature; and the fossilized plants, though not fully understood, support this idea as well, with Cycadeæ being the most common family.

But it is from the more ancient coal-deposits that the most extraordinary evidence has been supplied in proof of the former existence of a very different climate—a climate which seems to have been moist, warm, and extremely uniform, in those very latitudes which are now the colder, and in regard to temperature, the most variable regions of the globe. We learn from the researches of Adolphe Brongniart, Goeppert, and other botanists, that in the flora of the carboniferous era there was a great predominance of ferns, some of which were arborescent; as, for example, Caulopteris, Protopteris, and Psarronius; nor can this be accounted for, as some have supposed, by the greater power which ferns possess of resisting maceration in water.155 This prevalence of ferns indicates a moist, equable, and temperate climate, and the absence of any severe cold; for such are the conditions which, at the present day, are found to be most favorable to that tribe of plants. It is only in the islands of the tropical oceans, and of the southern temperate zone, such as Norfolk Island, Otaheite, the Sandwich Islands, Tristan d'Acunha, and New Zealand, that we find any near approach to that remarkable preponderance of ferns which is characteristic of the Carboniferous flora. It has been observed that tree ferns and other forms of vegetation which flourished most luxuriantly within the tropics, extend to a much greater distance from the equator in the southern hemisphere than in the northern, being found even as far as 46° S. latitude in New Zealand. There is little doubt that this is owing to the more uniform and moist climate occasioned by the greater proportional area of sea. Next to ferns and pines, the most abundant vegetable forms in the coal formation are the Calamites, Lepidodendra, Sigillariæ, and Stigmariæ. These were formerly considered to be so closely allied to tropical genera, and to be so much greater in size than the corresponding tribes now inhabiting equatorial latitudes, that they were thought to imply an extremely hot, as well as humid and equable climate. But recent discoveries respecting the structure and relations of these fossil plants, have shown that they deviated so widely from all existing types in the vegetable world, that we have more reason to infer from this evidence a widely different climate in the Carboniferous era, as compared to that now prevailing, than a temperature extremely elevated.156 Palms, if not entirely 88wanting when the strata of the carboniferous group were deposited, appear to have been exceedingly rare.157 The Coniferæ, on the other hand, so abundantly met with in the coal, resemble Araucariæ in structure, a family of the fir tribe, characteristic at present of the milder regions of the southern hemisphere, such as Chili, Brazil, New Holland, and Norfolk Island.

But it’s the older coal deposits that provide the most amazing evidence of a completely different climate—one that appears to have been moist, warm, and very consistent in areas that are now colder and the most temperature-variable regions of the world. Research by Adolphe Brongniart, Goeppert, and other botanists shows that during the carboniferous era, ferns were the dominant plants, including some tree-like forms like Caulopteris, Protopteris, and Psarronius. This abundance can’t just be explained by ferns being better at withstanding soaking in water. This prevalence of ferns indicates a moist, mild, and stable climate, with no severe cold, as these are the conditions that currently favor these plants. Today, we only find a similar abundance of ferns in tropical islands and in parts of the southern temperate zone, like Norfolk Island, Tahiti, the Sandwich Islands, Tristan da Cunha, and New Zealand. It’s noted that tree ferns and other vegetation that thrived in the tropics extend much farther from the equator in the southern hemisphere than in the northern, reaching up to 46° S latitude in New Zealand. There’s little doubt this is due to the milder and moist climate from the larger areas of sea. After ferns and pines, the most common plants in the coal formations are Calamites, Lepidodendra, Sigillariæ, and Stigmariæ. These plants were once thought to be closely related to tropical species and much larger than those found today in equatorial regions, leading to the belief that they indicated an extremely hot, as well as humid and consistent climate. However, recent findings about the structure and relationships of these fossil plants suggest that they were quite different from any existing plant types, leading us to conclude that the climate during the Carboniferous period was very different from what we have now, rather than being extremely hot. Palms, if they existed at all when the carboniferous layers were formed, seem to have been very rare. In contrast, the Coniferæ, commonly found in coal, resemble Araucariæ in structure, which is a family of firs that are currently typical of the milder regions of the southern hemisphere, like Chile, Brazil, New Holland, and Norfolk Island.

"In regard to the geographical extent of the ancient vegetation, it was not confined," says M. Brongniart, "to a small space, as to Europe, for example; for the same forms are met with again at great distances. Thus, the coal-plants of North America are, for the most part, identical with those of Europe, and all belong to the same genera. Some specimens, also, from Greenland, are referable to ferns, analogous to those of our European coal-mines."158 The fossil plants brought from Melville Island, although in a very imperfect state, have been supposed to warrant similar conclusions;159 and assuming that they agree with those of Baffin's Bay, mentioned by M. Brongniart, how shall we explain the manner in which such a vegetation lived through an arctic night of several months' duration?160

"In terms of the geographical range of ancient vegetation, it wasn't limited," says M. Brongniart, "to a small area, like Europe, for instance; similar forms can be found at great distances. For example, the coal plants in North America are mostly identical to those in Europe, and they all belong to the same genera. Some specimens from Greenland also belong to ferns similar to those found in our European coal mines."158 The fossil plants brought from Melville Island, although in very poor condition, have been thought to support similar conclusions;159 and if we assume they are similar to those from Baffin's Bay, mentioned by M. Brongniart, how can we explain how such vegetation survived an Arctic night lasting several months?160

It may seem premature to discuss this question until the true nature of the fossil flora of the arctic regions has been more accurately determined; yet, as the question has attracted some attention, let us assume for a moment that the coal-plants of Melville Island are strictly analogous to those of the strata of Northumberland—would such a fact present an inexplicable enigma to the vegetable physiologist?

It might seem too early to talk about this question until we have a clearer understanding of the fossil plants in the Arctic; however, since this question has gained some interest, let’s assume for a moment that the coal plants of Melville Island are exactly like those in the layers of Northumberland—would this fact pose an unsolvable mystery to the plant scientist?

89Plants, it is affirmed, cannot remain in darkness, even for a week, without serious injury, unless in a torpid state; and if exposed to heat and moisture they cannot remain torpid, but will grow, and must therefore perish. If, then, in the latitude of Melville Island, 75° N., a high temperature, and consequent humidity, prevailed at that period when we know the arctic seas were filled with corals and large multilocular shells, how could plants of tropical forms have flourished? Is not the bright light of equatorial regions as indispensable a condition of their well-being as the sultry heat of the same countries? and how could they annually endure a night prolonged for three months?161

89It's said that plants can't stay in the dark for even a week without suffering serious damage, unless they're in a dormant state; and if they're exposed to heat and moisture, they can't stay dormant but will start to grow, which means they'll end up dying. So, if in the latitude of Melville Island, 75° N., there was a high temperature and resulting humidity during the time when we know the Arctic seas were filled with corals and large multi-chambered shells, how could tropical plants have thrived? Isn't the bright light of equatorial regions just as essential for their health as the sweltering heat found in those areas? And how could they survive a night that lasts for three months each year?161

Now, in reply to this objection, we must bear in mind, in the first place, that, so far as experiments have been made, there is every reason to conclude, that the range of intensity of light to which living plants can accommodate themselves is far wider than that of heat. No palms or tree ferns can live in our temperate latitudes without protection from the cold; but when placed in hot-houses they grow luxuriantly, even under a cloudy sky, and where much light is intercepted by the glass and frame-work. At St. Petersburg, in lat. 60° N., these plants have been successfully cultivated in hot-houses, although there they must exchange the perpetual equinox of their native regions, for days and nights which are alternately protracted to nineteen hours and shortened to five. How much farther towards the pole they might continue to live, provided a due quantity of heat and moisture were supplied, has not yet been determined; but St. Petersburg is probably not the utmost limit, and we should expect that in lat. 65° at least, where they would never remain twenty-four hours without enjoying the sun's light, they might still exist.

Now, in response to this objection, we need to keep in mind that, based on what experiments have shown, living plants can adapt to a much wider range of light intensity than they can to heat. No palms or tree ferns can survive in our temperate climates without protection from the cold; however, when placed in greenhouses, they thrive even under cloudy skies, where a lot of light is blocked by the glass and framework. In St. Petersburg, at 60° N latitude, these plants have been successfully grown in greenhouses, even though they have to trade the constant equinox of their native regions for days and nights that alternate between being stretched to nineteen hours and shortened to five. It hasn't been determined how much further north they could survive if given enough heat and moisture, but St. Petersburg is likely not the ultimate limit. We would expect that at least at 65° N latitude, where they would never go twenty-four hours without sun, they could still thrive.

It should also be borne in mind, in regard to tree ferns, that they grow in the gloomiest and darkest parts of the forests of warm and temperate regions, even extending to nearly the 46th degree of south latitude in New Zealand. In equatorial countries, says Humboldt, they abound chiefly in the temperate, humid, and shady parts of mountains. As we know, therefore, that elevation often compensates for the effect of latitude in the geographical distribution of plants, we may easily understand that a class of vegetables, which grows at a certain height in the torrid zone, would flourish on the plains at greater distances from the equator, if the temperature, moisture, and other necessary conditions, were equally uniform throughout the year.

It should also be noted that tree ferns grow in the darkest and most shaded areas of warm and temperate forests, reaching almost the 46th degree of south latitude in New Zealand. In equatorial regions, Humboldt points out, they mainly thrive in the cool, humid, and shaded areas of mountains. Since we understand that elevation can often balance out the effects of latitude in plant distribution, it makes sense that a type of plant that grows at a certain height in the tropics could also thrive on the plains further away from the equator, as long as the temperature, moisture, and other necessary conditions remain consistently favorable throughout the year.

Nor must we forget that in all the examples above alluded to, we have been speaking of living species; but the coal-plants were of perfectly distinct species, nay, few of them except the ferns and pines can be referred to genera or even families of the existing vegetable kingdom. Having a structure, therefore, and often a form which appears to the botanist so anomalous, they may also have been endowed with a differ90ent constitution, enabling them to bear a greater variation of circumstances in regard to light. We find that particular species of plants and tree ferns require at present different degrees of heat; and that some species can thrive only in the immediate neighborhood of the equator, others only a distance from it. In the same manner the minimum of light, sufficient for the now existing species, cannot be taken as the standard for all analogous tribes that may ever have flourished on the globe.

We shouldn't forget that in all the examples mentioned above, we've been talking about living species; however, the coal plants belonged to completely different species, and few of them, aside from ferns and pines, can be classified into the same genera or even families as those in today's plant kingdom. They had structures and often forms that seem quite unusual to botanists, and they might have possessed a very different constitution that allowed them to adapt to a wider range of light conditions. We observe that certain species of plants and tree ferns now require different levels of heat; some species can only thrive close to the equator, while others prefer to be far away from it. Similarly, the minimum of light needed for today’s existing species shouldn’t be considered a standard for all similar groups that may have existed on Earth.

But granting that the extreme northern point to which a flora like that of the Carboniferous era could ever reach, may be somewhere between the latitudes of 65° and 70°, we should still have to inquire whether the vegetable remains might not have been drifted from thence, by rivers and currents, to the parallel of Melville Island, or still farther. In the northern hemisphere, at present, we see that the materials for future beds of lignite and coal are becoming amassed in high latitudes, far from the districts where the forests grew, and on shores where scarcely a stunted shrub can now exist. The Mackenzie, and other rivers of North America, carry pines with their roots attached for many hundred miles towards the north, into the Arctic Sea, where they are imbedded in deltas, and some of them drifted still farther by currents towards the pole.

But if we assume that the farthest north a plant life like that from the Carboniferous period could reach is somewhere between 65° and 70° latitude, we still need to consider whether the plant remains might have been carried from there by rivers and currents to the area around Melville Island or even further. In the northern hemisphere right now, we see that materials for future layers of lignite and coal are accumulating at high latitudes, far from where the forests actually grew, and on shores where hardly any stunted shrubs can survive. The Mackenzie and other rivers in North America transport pine trees with their roots still attached for hundreds of miles northward into the Arctic Sea, where they get buried in deltas, and some are even carried further by currents toward the pole.

Before we can decide on this question of transportation, we must know whether the fossil coal-plants occurring in high latitudes bear the marks of friction and of having decayed previously to fossilization. Many appearances in our English coal-fields certainly prove that the plants were not floated from great distances; for the outline of the stems of succulent species preserve their sharp angles, and others have their surfaces marked with the most delicate lines and streaks. Long leaves, also, are attached in many instances to the trunks or branches;162 and leaves, we know, in general, are soon destroyed when steeped in water, although ferns will retain their forms after an immersion of many months.163 It seems fair to presume, that most of the coal-plants grew upon the same land which supplied materials for the sandstones and conglomerates of the strata in which they are imbedded. The coarseness of the particles of many of these rocks attests that they were not borne from very remote localities, and that there was land therefore in the vicinity wasting away by the action of moving waters. The progress also of modern discovery has led to the very general admission of the doctrine that beds of coal have for the most part been formed of the remains of trees and plants that grew on the spot where the coal now exists; the land having been successively submerged, so that a covering of mud and sand was deposited upon accumulations of vegetable mater. That such has been the origin of some coal-seams is proved by the upright position of fossil trees, both in 91Europe and America, in which the roots terminate downwards in beds of coal.164

Before we can decide on this question of transportation, we need to know whether the fossil coal plants found in high latitudes show signs of wear and whether they decayed before becoming fossils. Many features in our English coal fields clearly indicate that the plants weren’t carried from far away; for instance, the outlines of the stems of succulent species retain their sharp angles, and others have surfaces marked with fine lines and streaks. Long leaves are also often attached to the trunks or branches; 162 and leaves, in general, tend to deteriorate quickly when submerged in water, although ferns can keep their shape after being underwater for many months.163 It seems reasonable to assume that most of the coal plants grew on the same land that provided the materials for the sandstones and conglomerates in which they’re found. The rough texture of the particles in many of these rocks indicates they weren’t transported from very distant places, suggesting that there was nearby land eroding due to water movement. Moreover, recent discoveries have led to a widely accepted idea that coal beds mainly formed from the remains of trees and plants that grew right where the coal is now; the land was submerged over time, allowing mud and sand to cover the accumulated plant material. The upright position of fossil trees, both in 91Europe and America, which have roots ending downward in coal beds, proves that this is the origin of some coal seams.164

To return, therefore, from this digression,—the flora of the coal appears to indicate a uniform and mild temperature in the air, while the fossils of the contemporaneous mountain-limestone, comprising abundance of lamelliferous corals, large chambered cephalopods, and crinoidea, naturally lead us to infer a considerable warmth in the waters of the northern sea of the Carboniferous period. So also in regard to strata older than the coal, they contain in high northern latitudes mountain masses of corals which must have lived and grown on the spot, and large chambered univalves, such as Orthocerata and Nautilus, all seeming to indicate, even in regions bordering on the arctic circle, the former prevalence of a temperature more elevated than that now prevailing.

To get back to the point— the plant life from the coal shows that the air had a consistent and mild temperature, while the fossils found in the nearby mountain limestone, which include abundant flat corals, large chambered cephalopods, and crinoids, suggest that the waters of the northern sea during the Carboniferous period were quite warm. Similarly, looking at the layers older than the coal, we find mountain masses of corals in high northern areas that must have lived and thrived there, as well as large chambered single-shelled creatures like Orthoceras and Nautilus, all pointing to a time when even regions close to the Arctic Circle were warmer than they are now.

The warmth and humidity of the air, and the uniformity of climate, both in the different seasons of the year, and in different latitudes, appears to have been most remarkable when some of the oldest of the fossiliferous strata were formed. The approximation to a climate similar to that now enjoyed in these latitudes does not commence till the era of the formations termed tertiary; and while the different tertiary rocks were deposited in succession, from the eocene to the pliocene, the temperature seems to have been lowered, and to have continued to diminish even after the appearance upon the earth of a considerable number of the existing species, the cold reaching its maximum of intensity in European latitudes during the glacial epoch, or the epoch immediately antecedent to that in which all the species now contemporary with man were in being.

The warmth and humidity of the air, along with the consistency of the climate during different seasons and in various latitudes, seems to have been especially notable when some of the oldest fossil-rich layers were formed. A climate similar to what we experience in these latitudes today didn’t start to develop until the era of the formations called tertiary; and as the different tertiary rocks were laid down in order, from the eocene to the pliocene, the temperature appears to have dropped, continuing to decrease even after a significant number of existing species appeared on Earth. The cold hit its peak intensity in European latitudes during the glacial period, which came right before the time when all the species that exist alongside humans today were alive.


CHAPTER VII.

FARTHER EXAMINATION OF THE QUESTION AS TO THE ASSUMED DISCORDANCE OF THE ANCIENT AND MODERN CAUSES OF CHANGE.

On the causes of vicissitudes in climate—Remarks on the present diffusion of heat over the globe—On the dependence of the mean temperature on the relative position of land and sea—Isothermal Lines—Currents from equatorial regions—Drifting of icebergs—Different temperature of Northern and Southern hemispheres—Combination of causes which might produce the extreme cold of which the earth's surface is susceptible—Conditions necessary for the production of the extreme of heat, and its probable effects on organic life.

On the causes of changes in climate—Observations on the current spread of heat around the world—On how the average temperature relies on the layout of land and water—Isothermal lines—Currents from equatorial areas—The drifting of icebergs—The different temperatures of the Northern and Southern hemispheres—A mix of factors that could lead to the extreme cold that the Earth's surface can experience—Conditions required for producing extreme heat and its likely impacts on living organisms.

Causes of Vicissitudes in Climate.165—As the proofs enumerated in the last chapter indicate that the earth's surface has experienced great changes of climate since the deposition of the older sedimentary strata, we have next to inquire how such vicissitudes can be reconciled with the existing order of nature. The cosmogonist has availed himself of this, as of every obscure problem in geology, to confirm his views concerning a period when the planet was in a nascent or half-formed state, or when the laws of the animate and inanimate world differed essentially from those now established; and he has in this, as in many other cases, succeeded so far, as to divert attention from that class of facts which, if fully understood, might probably lead to an explanation of the phenomena. At first it was imagined that the earth's axis had been for ages perpendicular to the plane of the ecliptic, so that there was a perpetual equinox, and uniformity of seasons throughout the year;—that the planet enjoyed this "paradisiacal" state until the era of the great flood; but in that catastrophe, whether by the shock of a comet, or some other convulsion, it lost its equal poise, and hence the obliquity of its axis, and with that the varied seasons of the temperate zone, and the long nights and days of the polar circles.

Causes of Changes in Climate.165—As the evidence discussed in the last chapter shows, the earth's surface has gone through significant climate changes since the older sedimentary layers were deposited. Next, we need to look into how these changes can be explained within the current understanding of nature. The cosmogonist has used this, like every complex issue in geology, to support his theories about a time when the planet was in an early or unfinished state, or when the natural laws governing living and non-living things were fundamentally different from those we recognize today. In doing so, he has, as in many other instances, managed to distract from a group of facts that, if fully understood, might lead to a clearer explanation of these phenomena. Initially, it was thought that the earth's axis had for eons been perpendicular to the plane of the ecliptic, resulting in a perpetual equinox and consistent seasons year-round; that the planet existed in this "paradise-like" condition until the time of the great flood. However, during that event, whether due to the impact of a comet or some other upheaval, it lost its balanced position, leading to the tilt of its axis and, consequently, the diverse seasons of the temperate zones and the extended nights and days in the polar regions.

When the progress of astronomical science had exploded this theory, it was assumed, that the earth at its creation was in a state of fluidity, and red-hot, and that ever since that era, it had been cooling down, contracting its dimensions, and acquiring a solid crust,—an hypothesis hardly less arbitrary, yet more calculated for lasting popularity; because, by referring the mind directly to the beginning of things, it requires no support from observation, nor from any ulterior hypothesis. But if, instead 93of forming vague conjectures as to what might have been the state of the planet at the era of its creation, we fix our thoughts on the connection at present existing between climate and the distribution of land and sea; and then consider what influence former fluctuations in the physical geography of the earth must have had on superficial temperature, we may perhaps approximate to a true theory. If doubts and obscurities still remain, they should be ascribed to our limited acquaintance with the laws of Nature, not to revolutions in her economy;—they should stimulate us to farther research, not tempt us to indulge our fancies respecting the imaginary changes of internal temperature in an embryo world.

When the advances in astronomy shattered this theory, it was believed that the Earth, at its creation, was molten and extremely hot, and that ever since then, it had been cooling down, shrinking in size, and forming a solid crust—an idea that was no less arbitrary but seemed more likely to gain lasting popularity; because it draws the mind directly to the beginning of everything, requiring no support from observation or any further hypotheses. But instead of making vague guesses about what the planet might have been like at the moment of its creation, if we focus on the current relationship between climate and the distribution of land and sea, and then think about how past changes in the Earth’s physical geography could have affected surface temperatures, we might get closer to a true theory. If uncertainties and ambiguities still exist, they should be attributed to our limited understanding of the laws of nature, not to upheavals in nature’s workings; they should motivate us to seek further research, not lead us to indulge in wild speculations about imaginary changes in internal temperature during the Earth's early days.

Diffusion of Heat over the Globe.—In considering the laws which regulate the diffusion of heat over the globe, we must be careful, as Humboldt well remarks, not to regard the climate of Europe as a type of the temperature which all countries placed under the same latitude enjoy. The physical sciences, observes this philosopher, always bear the impress of the places where they began to be cultivated; and as, in geology, an attempt was at first made to refer all the volcanic phenomena to those of the volcanoes in Italy, so in meteorology, a small part of the old world, the centre of the primitive civilization of Europe, was for a long time considered a type to which the climate of all corresponding latitudes might be referred. But this region, constituting only one-seventh of the whole globe, proved eventually to be the exception to the general rule. For the same reason, we may warn the geologist to be on his guard, and not hastily to assume that the temperature of the earth in the present era is a type of that which most usually obtains, since he contemplates far mightier alterations in the position of land and sea, at different epochs, than those which now cause the climate of Europe to differ from that of other countries in the same parallels.

Diffusion of Heat over the Globe.—When we look at the laws that govern how heat spreads across the globe, we need to be careful, as Humboldt wisely points out, not to think of Europe's climate as a model for the temperatures experienced by all countries at the same latitude. This philosopher notes that the physical sciences reflect the places where they first developed; just as in geology, where early efforts tried to link all volcanic activity to the volcanoes in Italy, in meteorology, a small part of the old world—specifically, the heart of Europe's early civilization—was long seen as a standard for the climate of all regions in similar latitudes. However, this area, which makes up only one-seventh of the entire globe, ultimately turned out to be an exception to the general trends. Similarly, we can caution geologists to be careful and not quickly assume that today's earth temperature represents what is typically found, since they are witnessing far greater changes in land and sea positions across different eras than those causing Europe's climate to differ from that of other countries at the same latitude.

It is now well ascertained that zones of equal warmth, both in the atmosphere and in the waters of the ocean, are neither parallel to the equator nor to each other.166 It is also known that the mean annual temperature may be the same in two places which enjoy very different climates, for the seasons may be nearly uniform, or violently contrasted, so that the lines of equal winter temperature do not coincide with those of equal annual heat or isothermal lines. The deviations of all these lines from the same parallel of latitude are determined by a multitude of circumstances, among the principal of which are the position, direc94tion, and elevation of the continents and islands, the position and depths of the sea, and the direction of currents and of winds.

It is now well established that areas of equal warmth, both in the atmosphere and in the ocean waters, are not parallel to the equator or to each other.166 It is also known that the average annual temperature can be the same in two locations with very different climates, as the seasons might be nearly uniform or sharply contrasting, meaning that the lines of equal winter temperature do not match up with those of equal annual heat or isothermal lines. The differences in all these lines from the same parallel of latitude are influenced by a variety of factors, the main ones being the location, direction, and elevation of continents and islands, the location and depths of the sea, and the direction of currents and winds.

On comparing the two continents of Europe and America, it is found that places in the same latitudes have sometimes a mean difference of temperature amounting to 11°, or even in a few cases to 17° Fahr.; and some places on the two continents, which have the same mean temperature, differ from 7° to 17° in latitude. Thus, Cumberland House, in North America, having the same latitude (54° N.) as the city of York in England, stands on the isothermal line of 32°, which in Europe rises to the North Cape, in lat. 71°, but its summer heat exceeds that of Brussels or Paris.167 The principal cause of greater intensity of cold in corresponding latitudes of North America, as contrasted with Europe, is the connection of America with the polar circle, by a large tract of land, some of which is from three to five thousand feet in height; and, on the other hand, the separation of Europe from the arctic circle by an ocean. The ocean has a tendency to preserve everywhere a mean temperature, which it communicates to the contiguous land, so that it tempers the climate, moderating alike an excess of heat or cold. The elevated land, on the other hand, rising to the colder regions of the atmosphere, becomes a great reservoir of ice and snow, arrests, condenses, and congeals vapor, and communicates its cold to the adjoining country. For this reason, Greenland, forming part of a continent which stretches northward to the 82d degree of latitude, experiences under the 60th parallel a more rigorous climate than Lapland under the 72d parallel.

When comparing the continents of Europe and America, it's observed that locations at the same latitudes can have an average temperature difference of up to 11° or even 17° Fahrenheit in some cases. Additionally, some areas on both continents with the same average temperature can differ in latitude by 7° to 17°. For instance, Cumberland House in North America is at the same latitude (54° N.) as York in England, but it sits on the isothermal line of 32°, which in Europe reaches as far as the North Cape at latitude 71°. However, its summer temperatures are higher than those in Brussels or Paris. The primary reason for the greater cold intensity in corresponding latitudes of North America compared to Europe is America's connection to the polar circle through a vast landmass that rises from three to five thousand feet in elevation. In contrast, Europe is separated from the Arctic Circle by an ocean. The ocean tends to maintain a consistent average temperature, which it shares with nearby land, moderating both heat and cold in the climate. Conversely, the elevated land, reaching into colder atmospheric regions, acts as a major reservoir of ice and snow, capturing, condensing, and freezing vapor, which then cools the surrounding areas. This is why Greenland, part of a continent that extends north to the 82nd degree of latitude, has a harsher climate under the 60th parallel than Lapland does under the 72nd parallel.

But if land be situated between the 40th parallel and the equator, it produces, unless it be of extreme height, exactly the opposite effect; for it then warms the tracts of land or sea that intervene between it and the polar circle. For the surface being in this case exposed to the vertical, or nearly vertical rays of the sun, absorbs a large quantity of heat, which it diffuses by radiation into the atmosphere. For this reason, the western parts of the old continent derive warmth from Africa, "which, like an immense furnace, distributes its heat to Arabia, to Turkey in Asia, and to Europe."168 On the contrary, the northeastern extremity of Asia experiences in the same latitude extreme cold; for it has land on the north between the 60th and 70th parallel, while to the south it is separated from the equator by the Pacific Ocean.

But if land is located between the 40th parallel and the equator, it produces, unless it is extremely high, the exact opposite effect; it warms the areas of land or sea that lie between it and the polar circle. The surface, being exposed to the vertical or nearly vertical rays of the sun, absorbs a lot of heat, which it then radiates into the atmosphere. For this reason, the western parts of the old continent receive warmth from Africa, "which, like an immense furnace, distributes its heat to Arabia, to Turkey in Asia, and to Europe."168 In contrast, the northeastern tip of Asia experiences extreme cold in the same latitude; it has land to the north between the 60th and 70th parallels, while to the south, it is separated from the equator by the Pacific Ocean.

In consequence of the more equal temperature of the waters of the ocean, the climate of islands and of coasts differs essentially from that of the interior of continents, the more maritime climate being characterized by mild winters, and more temperate summers; for the sea-breezes moderate the cold of winter, as well as the heat of summer. When, therefore, we trace round the globe those belts in which the mean annual temperature is the same, we often find great differences in climate; for there are insular climates in which the seasons are nearly equalized, and 95excessive climates, as they have been termed, where the temperature of winter and summer is strongly contrasted. The whole of Europe, compared with the eastern parts of America and Asia, has an insular climate. The northern part of China, and the Atlantic region of the United States, exhibit "excessive climates." We find at New York, says Humboldt, the summer of Rome and the winter of Copenhagen; at Quebec, the summer of Paris and the winter of Petersburg. At Pekin, in China, where the mean temperature of the year is that of the coasts of Brittany, the scorching heats of summer are greater than at Cairo, and the winters as rigorous as at Upsala.169

As a result of the more consistent temperature of ocean waters, the climate of islands and coastal areas is fundamentally different from that of the interior of continents. The maritime climate features mild winters and more temperate summers because the sea breezes ease the cold of winter and the heat of summer. Therefore, when we trace around the globe the regions where the average annual temperature is the same, we often notice significant differences in climate. There are insular climates where the seasons are nearly balanced, and excessive climates, as they have been called, where there is a stark contrast between winter and summer temperatures. Overall, Europe, compared to the eastern parts of America and Asia, has an insular climate. Northern China and the Atlantic region of the United States show "excessive climates." In New York, Humboldt notes, you experience the summer of Rome and the winter of Copenhagen; in Quebec, it’s the summer of Paris and the winter of St. Petersburg. In Beijing, China, where the average annual temperature aligns with that of Brittany's coasts, the scorching summer heat surpasses that of Cairo, while the winters are as harsh as those in Uppsala.169

If lines be drawn round the globe through all those places which have the same winter temperature, they are found to deviate from the terrestrial parallels much farther than the lines of equal mean annual heat. The lines of equal winter in Europe, for example, are often curved so as to reach parallels of latitude 9° or 10° distant from each other, whereas the isothermal lines, or those passing through places having the same mean annual temperature, differ only from 4° to 5° in Europe.

If you draw lines around the world connecting all the places with the same winter temperature, you'll see that these lines drift away from the lines of latitude more than the lines of equal average annual heat do. For instance, in Europe, the lines of equal winter temperature often curve, ending up 9° or 10° apart in latitude, while the lines that show places with the same average annual temperature only differ by about 4° to 5°.

Influence of currents and drift ice on temperature.—Among other influential causes, both of remarkable diversity in the mean annual heat, and of unequal division of heat in the different seasons, are the direction of currents and the accumulation and drifting of ice in high latitudes. The temperature of the Lagullas current is 10° or 12° Fahr. above that of the sea at the Cape of Good Hope; for it derives the greater part of its waters from the Mozambique channel, and southeast coast of Africa, and from regions in the Indian Ocean much nearer the line, and much hotter than the Cape.170 An opposite effect is produced by the "equatorial" current, which crosses the Atlantic from Africa to Brazil, having a breadth varying from 160 to 450 nautical miles. Its waters are cooler by 3° or 4° Fahr. than those of the ocean under the line, so that it moderates the heat of the tropics.171

Influence of currents and drift ice on temperature.—Among other significant factors that greatly affect the average annual heat and cause uneven temperature distribution across different seasons are the direction of ocean currents and the accumulation and movement of ice in polar regions. The temperature of the Lagullas current is 10° to 12° Fahrenheit warmer than the sea temperature at the Cape of Good Hope; this is because it mainly gets its water from the Mozambique channel, the southeast coast of Africa, and areas in the Indian Ocean much closer to the equator and significantly hotter than the Cape.170 Conversely, the "equatorial" current traveling across the Atlantic from Africa to Brazil, which ranges from 160 to 450 nautical miles wide, has waters that are 3° to 4° Fahrenheit cooler than those of the ocean near the equator, thereby cooling down the heat in the tropics.171

But the effects of the Gulf stream on the climate of the North Atlantic Ocean are far more remarkable. This most powerful of known currents has its source in the Gulf or Sea of Mexico, which, like the Mediterranean and other close seas in temperate or low latitudes, is warmer than the open ocean in the same parallels. The temperature of the Mexican sea in summer is, according to Rennell, 86° Fahr., or at least 7° above that of the Atlantic in the same latitude.172 From this great reservoir or caldron of warm water, a constant current pours forth through the straits of Bahama at the rate of 3 or 4 miles an hour; it crosses the ocean in a northeasterly direction, skirting the great bank of Newfoundland, where it still retains a temperature of 8° above that of the surrounding sea. It reaches the Azores in about 78 days, after flowing nearly 3000 geographical miles, and from thence it some96times extends its course a thousand miles farther, so as to reach the Bay of Biscay, still retaining an excess of 5° above the mean temperature of that sea. As it has been known to arrive there in the months of November and January, it may tend greatly to moderate the cold of winter in countries on the west of Europe. . There is a large tract in the centre of the North Atlantic, between the parallels of 33° and 45° N. lat., which Rennell calls the "recipient of the gulf water." A great part of it is covered by the weed called sargasso (Sargassum bacciferum), which the current floats in abundance from the Gulf of Mexico. This mass of water is nearly stagnant, is warmer by 7° or 10° than the waters of the Atlantic, and may be compared to the fresh water of a river overflowing the heavier salt water of the sea. Rennell estimates the area of the "recipient," together with that covered by the main current, as being 2000 miles in length from E. to W., and 350 in breadth from N. to S., which, he remarks, is a larger area than that of the Mediterranean. The heat of this great body of water is kept up by the incessant and quick arrivals of fresh supplies of warm water from the south; and there can be no doubt that the general climate of parts of Europe and America is materially affected by this cause.

But the effects of the Gulf Stream on the climate of the North Atlantic Ocean are much more impressive. This strongest known current originates in the Gulf or Sea of Mexico, which, like the Mediterranean and other nearby seas in temperate or lower latitudes, is warmer than the open ocean at the same latitude. According to Rennell, the temperature of the Mexican sea in summer is 86° Fahrenheit, or at least 7° higher than that of the Atlantic at the same latitude.172 From this vast reservoir of warm water, a constant current flows through the straits of Bahama at a speed of 3 to 4 miles an hour; it crosses the ocean in a northeastern direction, passing by the great bank of Newfoundland, where it still maintains a temperature 8° above that of the surrounding sea. It reaches the Azores in about 78 days after traveling nearly 3,000 geographical miles, and from there it sometimes extends its route another thousand miles to reach the Bay of Biscay, still holding a temperature that’s 5° above the average temperature of that sea. Since it has been known to arrive there in November and January, it likely helps to warm the winter in regions of western Europe. There is a large area in the center of the North Atlantic, between the parallels of 33° and 45° N. latitude, which Rennell refers to as the "recipient of the gulf water." Much of it is covered by a type of weed called sargasso (Sargassum bacciferum), which the current carries abundantly from the Gulf of Mexico. This body of water is almost stagnant, 7° to 10° warmer than the waters of the Atlantic, and can be compared to fresh water from a river overflowing into the denser saltwater of the sea. Rennell estimates the area of the "recipient," along with the section covered by the main current, to be 2,000 miles long from east to west and 350 miles wide from north to south, which he points out is a larger area than that of the Mediterranean. The warmth of this large body of water is maintained by the constant influx of warm water from the south; and there’s no doubt that the general climate of parts of Europe and America is significantly influenced by this factor.

It is considered probable by Scoresby that the influence of the Gulf stream extends even to the sea near Spitzbergen, where its waters may pass under those of melted ice; for it has been found that in the neighborhood of Spitzbergen, the water is warmer by 6° or 7° at the depth of one hundred and two hundred fathoms than at the surface. This might arise from the known law that fresh water passes the point of greatest density when cooled down below 40°, and between that and the freezing point expands again. The water of melted ice might be lighter, both as being fresh (having lost its salt in the decomposing process of freezing), and because its temperature is nearer the freezing point than the inferior water of the Gulf stream.

Scoresby believes it’s likely that the Gulf Stream affects the waters near Spitzbergen, where its currents might flow beneath melted ice. Research shows that around Spitzbergen, the water is 6° to 7° warmer at depths of one hundred and two hundred fathoms compared to the surface. This could be due to the fact that fresh water reaches its maximum density below 40°, and between that and the freezing point, it actually expands again. The water from melted ice might be lighter because it’s fresh (having lost its salt during the freezing process) and its temperature is closer to the freezing point than the deeper waters of the Gulf Stream.

The great glaciers generated in the valleys of Spitzbergen, in the 79° of north latitude, are almost all cut off at the beach, being melted by the feeble remnant of heat still retained by the Gulf stream. In Baffin's Bay, on the contrary, on the west coast of Old Greenland, where the temperature of the sea is not mitigated by the same cause, and where there is no warmer under-current, the glaciers stretch out from the shore, and furnish repeated crops of mountainous masses of ice which float off into the ocean.173 The number and dimensions of these bergs is prodigious. Captain Sir John Ross saw several of them together in Baffin's Bay aground in water fifteen hundred feet deep! Many of them are driven down into Hudson's Bay, and accumulating there, diffuse excessive cold over the neighboring continent; so that Captain Franklin reports, that at the mouth of Hayes' River, which 97lies in the same latitude as the north of Prussia or the south of Scotland, ice is found everywhere in digging wells, in summer, at the depth of four feet! Other bergs have been occasionally met with, at midsummer, in a state of rapid thaw, as far south as lat. 40° and longitude about 60° west, where they cool the water sensibly to the distance of forty or fifty miles around, the thermometer sinking sometimes 17°, or even 18°, Fahrenheit, in their neighborhood.174 It is a well-known fact that every four or five years a large number of icebergs, floating from Greenland, double Cape Langaness, and are stranded on the west coast of Iceland. The inhabitants are then aware that their crops of hay will fail, in consequence of fogs which are generated almost incessantly; and the dearth of food is not confined to the land, for the temperature of the water is so changed that the fish entirely desert the coast.

The massive glaciers formed in the valleys of Spitzbergen, at 79° north latitude, largely end at the beach, where they are melted by the weak remaining heat of the Gulf Stream. In Baffin's Bay, on the other hand, along the west coast of Old Greenland, where the sea temperature isn’t warmed by the same effect and there are no warmer undercurrents, the glaciers extend out from the shore and produce large chunks of ice that float away into the ocean.173 The number and size of these icebergs are enormous. Captain Sir John Ross observed several of them in Baffin's Bay sitting in water that was fifteen hundred feet deep! Many of them are pushed into Hudson's Bay, where they accumulate and spread extreme cold across the nearby continent. Captain Franklin reports that at the mouth of Hayes' River, which is at the same latitude as northern Prussia or southern Scotland, ice can be found everywhere when digging wells, even in summer, at a depth of four feet! Other icebergs have occasionally been spotted in midsummer, melting rapidly as far south as latitude 40° and longitude about 60° west, cooling the water noticeably for forty or fifty miles around, with the thermometer dropping sometimes 17° or even 18° Fahrenheit in their vicinity.174 It’s well-known that every four or five years, a significant number of icebergs float away from Greenland, round Cape Langaness, and get stranded on the west coast of Iceland. The locals then realize that their hay crops will fail because of the fogs that are generated almost non-stop; and the lack of food isn’t just limited to land, as the temperature of the water changes so drastically that the fish completely abandon the coast.

Difference of climate of the Northern and Southern hemispheres.—When we compare the climate of the northern and southern hemispheres, we obtain still more instruction in regard to the influence of the distribution of land and sea on climate. The dry land in the southern hemisphere is to that of the northern in the ratio only of one to three, excluding from our consideration that part which lies between the pole and the 78° of south latitude, which has hitherto proved inaccessible. And whereas in the northern hemisphere, between the pole and the thirtieth parallel of north latitude, the land and sea occupy nearly equal areas, the ocean in the southern hemisphere covers no less than fifteen parts in sixteen of the entire space included between the antarctic circle and the thirtieth parallel of south latitude.

Difference of climate of the Northern and Southern hemispheres.—When we compare the climate of the northern and southern hemispheres, we gain more insights into how the distribution of land and sea affects climate. The amount of dry land in the southern hemisphere is only one-third that of the northern hemisphere, not considering the region between the pole and 78° south latitude, which has been impossible to access so far. In the northern hemisphere, between the pole and the thirtieth parallel of north latitude, land and sea cover nearly equal areas, while in the southern hemisphere, the ocean accounts for about fifteen out of sixteen parts of the entire area between the Antarctic Circle and the thirtieth parallel of south latitude.

This great extent of sea gives a particular character to climates south of the equator, the winters being mild and the summers cool. Thus, in Van Dieman's Land, corresponding nearly in latitude to Rome, the winters are more mild than at Naples, and the summers not warmer than those at Paris, which is 7° farther from the equator.175 The effects on animal and vegetable life are remarkable. Capt. King observed large shrubs of Fuchsia and Veronica, which in England are treated as tender plants, thriving and in full flower in Tierra del Fuego with the temperature at 36°. He states also that humming birds were seen sipping the sweets of the flowers "after two or three days of constant rain, snow, and sleet, during which time the thermometer had been at the freezing point." Mr. Darwin also saw parrots feeding on the seeds of a tree called the winter's bark, south of lat. 55°, near Cape Horn.176

The vast expanse of ocean gives a unique character to the climates south of the equator, with mild winters and cool summers. For example, in Van Dieman's Land, which is nearly at the same latitude as Rome, the winters are milder than in Naples, and the summers are no warmer than those in Paris, which is 7° further from the equator.175 The impacts on animal and plant life are remarkable. Captain King noticed large shrubs of Fuchsia and Veronica, which in England are treated as delicate plants, thriving and in full bloom in Tierra del Fuego with temperatures at 36°. He also mentioned that hummingbirds were seen drinking the nectar of the flowers "after two or three days of continuous rain, snow, and sleet, during which the temperature had been at freezing point." Mr. Darwin also observed parrots eating the seeds of a tree known as winter's bark, south of latitude 55°, near Cape Horn.176

So the orchideous plants which are parasitical on trees, and are generally characteristic of the tropics, advance to the 38th and 42d degree of S. lat., and even beyond the 45th degree in New Zealand, where they were found by Forster. In South America also arborescent grasses abound in the dense forests of Chiloe, in lat. 42° S., where "they entwine the trees into one entangled mass to the height of thirty or forty 98feet above the ground. Palm-trees in the same quarter of the globe grow in lat. 37°, an arborescent grass very like a bamboo in 40°, and another closely allied kind, of great length, but not erect, even as far south as 45°."177

So the orchid plants, which are parasitic on trees and are typically found in tropical regions, can be found as far south as the 38th and 42nd degrees of S. latitude, and even beyond the 45th degree in New Zealand, where Forster discovered them. In South America, tree-like grasses are abundant in the dense forests of Chiloe, at 42° S latitude, where "they wrap around the trees into one tangled mass up to thirty or forty 98 feet above the ground. Palm trees in that part of the world grow at 37° latitude, a tree-like grass similar to bamboo is found at 40°, and another closely related type, which is quite long but not upright, can be found as far south as 45°."177

It has long been supposed that the general temperature of the southern hemisphere was considerably lower than that of the northern, and that the difference amounted to at least 10° Fahrenheit. Baron Humboldt, after collecting and comparing a great number of observations, came to the conclusion that even a much larger difference existed, but that none was to be observed within the tropics, and only a small difference as far as the thirty-fifth and fortieth parallel. Captain Cook was of opinion that the ice of the antarctic predominated greatly over that of the arctic region, that encircling the southern pole coming nearer to the equator by 10° than the ice around the north pole. All the recent voyages of discovery have tended to confirm this opinion, although Capt. Weddel penetrated, in 1823, three degrees farther south than Capt. Cook, reaching lat. 74° 15' South, long. 34° 17' West, and Sir James Ross, in 1842, arrived at lat. 78° 10' S., as high a latitude, within three degrees, as the farthest point attained by Captain Parry in the arctic circle, or lat. 81° 12' North.

It has long been believed that the average temperature in the southern hemisphere is significantly lower than in the northern hemisphere, with a difference of at least 10° Fahrenheit. Baron Humboldt, after gathering and comparing a lot of observations, concluded that an even greater difference existed, though none could be seen within the tropics, and only a slight difference was noted up to the thirty-fifth and fortieth parallels. Captain Cook thought that the ice in the Antarctic greatly outweighed that in the Arctic region, with the ice surrounding the southern pole coming 10° closer to the equator than the ice near the north pole. Recent exploratory voyages have generally supported this view, although Captain Weddell traveled three degrees farther south in 1823 than Captain Cook, reaching lat. 74° 15' South, long. 34° 17' West, and Sir James Ross, in 1842, reached lat. 78° 10' S., which is just three degrees shy of the furthest point achieved by Captain Parry in the Arctic Circle at lat. 81° 12' North.

The description given by ancient as well as modern navigators of the sea and land in high southern latitudes, clearly attests the greater severity of the climate as compared to arctic regions. In Sandwich Land, in lat. 59° S., or in nearly the same parallel as the north of Scotland, Capt. Cook found the whole country, from the summits of the mountains down to the very brink of the sea-cliffs, "covered many fathoms thick with everlasting snow," and this on the 1st of February, the hottest time of the year; and what is still more astonishing, in the island of S. Georgia, which is in the 54° south latitude, or the same parallel as Yorkshire, the line of perpetual snow descends to the level of the ocean.178 When we consider this fact, and then recollect that the highest mountains in Scotland, which ascend to an elevation of nearly 5000 feet, and are four degrees farther to the north, do not attain the limit of perpetual snow on our side of the equator, we learn that latitude is one only of many powerful causes, which determine the climate of particular regions of the globe. Capt. Sir James Ross, in his exploring expedition in 1841-3, found that the temperature south of the 60th degree of latitude seldom rose above 32° Fahr. During the two summer months of the year 1841 (January and February) the range of the thermometer was between 11° and 32° Fahr.; and scarcely once rose above the freezing point. The permanence of snow in the southern hemisphere, is in this instance partly due to the floating ice, which chills the atmosphere and condenses the 99vapor, so that in summer the sun cannot pierce through the foggy air. But besides the abundance of ice which covers the sea to the south of Georgia and Sandwich Land, we may also, as Humboldt suggests, ascribe the cold of those countries in part to the absence of land between them and the tropics.

The descriptions from both ancient and modern navigators about the sea and land in the high southern latitudes clearly show that the climate is harsher compared to arctic regions. In Sandwich Land, at 59° S latitude, which is about the same parallel as northern Scotland, Captain Cook found the entire area, from the mountain tops to the very edge of the sea cliffs, "covered many fathoms thick with everlasting snow," even on February 1st, the hottest time of the year. What’s even more surprising is that on the island of South Georgia, which is at 54° S latitude, the line of perpetual snow reaches sea level. When we consider this fact, and then remember that the highest mountains in Scotland, which rise to nearly 5000 feet and are four degrees further north, do not reach the limit of perpetual snow on our side of the equator, we realize that latitude is just one of many factors that influence the climate of specific regions of the globe. Captain Sir James Ross, during his exploration from 1841 to 1843, found that temperatures south of the 60th degree latitude rarely exceeded 32° Fahrenheit. Throughout the two summer months of 1841 (January and February), the thermometer ranged from 11° to 32° Fahrenheit, and rarely went above freezing. The persistence of snow in the southern hemisphere is partly due to the floating ice, which cools the atmosphere and condenses the vapor, preventing the sun from penetrating through the foggy air in summer. Additionally, as Humboldt suggests, we can attribute the cold in these countries partly to the lack of land between them and the tropics.

If Africa and New Holland extended farther to the south, a diminution of ice would take place in consequence of the radiation of heat from these continents during summer, which would warm the contiguous sea and rarefy the air. The heated aerial currents would then ascend and flow more rapidly towards the south pole, and moderate the winter. In confirmation of these views, it is stated that the ice, which extends as far as the 68° and 71° of south latitude, advances more towards the equator whenever it meets an open sea; that is, where the extremities of the present continents are not opposite to it; and this circumstance seems explicable only on the principle above alluded to, of the radiation of heat from the lands so situated.

If Africa and New Holland stretched further south, there would be less ice because these continents would radiate heat during the summer, warming the nearby sea and thinning the air. The heated air currents would rise and move more quickly toward the South Pole, moderating the winter. To support this idea, it's noted that the ice, which reaches as far as 68° and 71° south latitude, moves closer to the equator whenever it encounters open sea—specifically where the ends of the current continents aren't opposite it. This situation seems to make sense only based on the principle mentioned earlier regarding the heat radiation from the lands in that position.

The cold of the antarctic regions was conjectured by Cook to be due to the existence of a large tract of land between the seventieth degree of south latitude and the pole. The justness of these and other speculations of that great navigator have since been singularly confirmed by the investigation made by Sir James Ross in 1841. He found Victoria Land, extending from 71° to 79° S. latitude, skirted by a great barrier of ice, the height of the land ranging from 4000 to 14,000 feet, the whole entirely covered with snow, except a narrow ring of black earth surrounding the huge crater of the active volcano of Mount Erebus, rising 12,400 feet above the level of the sea. The position of a mountainous territory of such altitude, so near the pole, and so obvious a source of intense cold, fully explains why Graham's and Enderby's Land, discovered by Captain Biscoe in 1831-2 (between lat. 64° and 68° S.), presented a most wintry aspect, covered even in summer with ice and snow, and nearly destitute of animal life. In corresponding latitudes of the northern hemisphere we not only meet with herds of wild herbivorous animals, but with land which man himself inhabits, and where he has even built ports and inland villages.179

The cold in the Antarctic regions was believed by Cook to result from a large landmass located between the 70th degree of south latitude and the pole. The accuracy of these and other theories from that great navigator has since been remarkably verified by investigations conducted by Sir James Ross in 1841. He discovered Victoria Land, which stretches from 71° to 79° S. latitude, bordered by a massive ice barrier, with the land's elevation ranging from 4,000 to 14,000 feet, completely covered in snow except for a narrow band of dark soil around the large crater of the active volcano Mount Erebus, which rises 12,400 feet above sea level. The existence of such a high mountainous area so close to the pole, which is a clear source of extreme cold, explains why Graham's and Enderby's Land, found by Captain Biscoe in 1831-32 (between lat. 64° and 68° S.), appeared very wintry, remaining covered in ice and snow even during summer and being almost devoid of animal life. In comparable latitudes in the northern hemisphere, we not only find herds of wild herbivorous animals but also land that humans inhabit, where they have even constructed ports and inland villages.179

The distance to which icebergs float from the polar regions on the opposite sides of the line is, as might have been anticipated, very different. Their extreme limit in the northern hemisphere is lat. 40°, as before mentioned, and they are occasionally seen in lat. 42° N., near the termination of the great bank of Newfoundland, and at the Azores, lat. 42° N., to which they are sometimes drifted from Baffin's Bay. But in the other hemisphere they have been seen, within the last few years, at different points off the Cape of Good Hope, between lat. 10036° and 39°.180 One of these (see fig. 2.) was two miles in circumference, and 150 feet high, appearing like chalk when the sun was obscured, and having the lustre of refined sugar when the sun was shining on it. Others rose from 250 to 300 feet above the level of the sea, and were therefore of great volume below; since it is ascertained by experiments on the buoyancy of ice floating in sea-water, that for every cubic foot seen above, there must at least be eight cubic feet below water.181 If ice islands from the north polar regions floated as far, they might reach Cape St. Vincent, and there, being drawn by the current that always sets in from the Atlantic through the Straits of Gibraltar, be drifted into the Mediterranean, so that the serene sky of that delightful region might soon be deformed by clouds and mists.

The distance that icebergs drift from the polar regions on opposite sides of the line is, as expected, quite different. Their farthest point in the northern hemisphere is at 40° latitude, as previously mentioned, and they are sometimes spotted at 42° N, near the edge of the Grand Banks of Newfoundland, and at the Azores, also at 42° N, to which they occasionally drift from Baffin's Bay. However, in the southern hemisphere, they have been spotted in recent years at various locations off the Cape of Good Hope, between 36° and 39° latitude.100 One of these (see fig. 2.) was two miles around and 150 feet high, looking like chalk when the sun was hidden and shining with the shine of refined sugar when illuminated. Others rose from 250 to 300 feet above sea level, indicating a substantial volume below the surface; experiments show that for every cubic foot visible above water, there must be at least eight cubic feet submerged.181 If ice islands from the northern polar regions floated that far, they could potentially reach Cape St. Vincent, where they would be carried by the current that flows in from the Atlantic through the Straits of Gibraltar, drifting into the Mediterranean, thereby marring the clear skies of that beautiful area with clouds and mist.

Fig. 2.Iceberg seen off the Cape of Good Hope,

Iceberg seen off the Cape of Good Hope, April, 1829. Lat. 89º 18' S. Long. 48° 46' E.

Iceberg spotted near the Cape of Good Hope, April 1829. Lat. 89º 18' S. Long. 48° 46' E.

Before the amount of difference between the temperature of the two hemispheres was ascertained, it was referred by many astronomers to the precession of the equinoxes, or the acceleration of the earth's motion in its perihelium; in consequence of which the spring and summer of the southern hemisphere are now shorter, by nearly eight days, than those seasons north of the equator. But Sir J. Herschel reminds us that the excess of eight days in the duration of the sun's presence in the northern hemisphere is not productive of an excess of annual light and heat; since, according to the laws of elliptic motion, it is demonstrable that whatever be the ellipticity of the earth's orbit, the two hemispheres must receive equal absolute quantities of light and heat per annum, the proximity of the sun in perigee exactly compensating the effect of its swifter motion.182 Humboldt, however, observes, that there must be a greater loss of heat by radiation in the southern hemi101sphere during a winter longer by eight days than that on the other side of the equator.183

Before the difference in temperature between the two hemispheres was understood, many astronomers attributed it to the precession of the equinoxes or the speeding up of the Earth's motion at its closest point to the sun. As a result, spring and summer in the southern hemisphere are now about eight days shorter than those seasons north of the equator. However, Sir J. Herschel points out that the extra eight days of sunshine in the northern hemisphere doesn't lead to an increase in annual light and heat. According to the laws of elliptical motion, regardless of the Earth's orbital shape, both hemispheres receive equal absolute quantities of light and heat each year, as the sun's proximity at its closest point balances the effects of its faster movement.182 Humboldt, however, notes that there must be a greater heat loss due to radiation in the southern hemisphere during a winter that's eight days longer than in the northern hemisphere.183

Perhaps no very sensible effect may be produced by this source of disturbance; yet the geologist should bear in mind that to a certain extent it operates alternately on each of the two hemispheres for a period of upwards of 10,000 years, dividing unequally the times during which the annual supply of solar light and heat is received. This cause may sometimes tend to counterbalance inequalities of temperature resulting from other far more influential circumstances; but, on the other hand, it must sometimes tend to increase the extreme of deviation arising from particular combinations of causes.

Maybe this source of disturbance won’t have a huge effect, but geologists should remember that it operates alternately on both hemispheres for more than 10,000 years, unevenly splitting the times when they receive solar light and heat every year. This factor might sometimes help to balance out temperature differences caused by other, more significant factors; however, it can also sometimes increase the extremes caused by specific combinations of these factors.

But whatever may be at present the inferiority of heat in the temperate and frigid zones south of the line, it is quite evident that the cold would be far more intense if there happened, instead of open sea, to be tracts of elevated land between the 55th and 70th parallel; and, on the other hand, the cold would be moderated if there were more land between the line and the forty-fifth degree of south latitude.

But no matter how much less heat there is right now in the temperate and polar regions south of the equator, it's clear that the cold would be much stronger if there were elevated land instead of open sea between the 55th and 70th parallels; on the flip side, the cold would be less severe if there were more land between the equator and the 45th degree of south latitude.

Changes in the position of land and sea may give rise to vicissitudes in climate.—Having offered these brief remarks on the diffusion of heat over the globe in the present state of the surface, I shall now proceed to speculate on the vicissitudes of climate, which must attend those endless variations in the geographical features of our planet which are contemplated in geology. That our speculations may be confined within the strict limits of analogy, I shall assume, 1st, That the proportion of dry land to sea continues always the same. 2dly, That the volume of the land rising above the level of the sea is a constant quantity; and not only that its mean, but that its extreme height, is liable only to trifling variations. 3dly, That both the mean and extreme depth of the sea are invariable; and 4thly, It may be consistent with due caution to assume that the grouping together of the land in continents is a necessary part of the economy of nature; for it is possible that the laws which govern the subterranean forces, and which act simultaneously along certain lines, cannot but produce, at every epoch, continuous mountain-chains; so that the subdivision of the whole land into innumerable islands may be precluded.

Changes in the position of land and sea can lead to shifts in climate.—Having made these brief comments on the distribution of heat around the world based on the current state of the surface, I will now begin to explore the changes in climate that must occur alongside the endless variations in the geographical features of our planet as discussed in geology. To keep our thoughts within the strict boundaries of analogy, I'll assume, 1st, that the ratio of land to sea remains constant. 2nd, that the amount of land above sea level is a constant quantity; and not only its average but also its maximum height will only experience minor fluctuations. 3rd, that both the average and maximum depth of the sea are unchanging; and 4th, it may be reasonable to assume that the arrangement of land into continents is an essential part of nature's design; as the forces beneath the surface, which operate along specific lines, must continuously create mountain ranges throughout time, making it unlikely for all land to break into countless islands.

If it be objected, that the maximum of elevation of land and depth of sea are probably not constant, nor the gathering together of all the land in certain parts, nor even perhaps the relative extent of land and water, I reply, that the arguments about to be adduced will be strengthened if, in these peculiarities of the surface, there be considerable deviations from the present type. If, for example, all other circumstances being the same, the land is at one time more divided into islands than at another, a greater uniformity of climate might be produced, the mean temperature remaining unaltered; or if, at another era, there were mountains higher than the Himalaya, these, when placed in 102high latitudes, would cause a greater excess of cold. Or, if we suppose that at certain periods no chain of hills in the world rose beyond the height of 10,000 feet, a greater heat might then have prevailed than is compatible with the existence of mountains thrice that elevation.

If someone argues that the highest points of land and the deepest parts of the sea probably aren't constant, nor is the arrangement of land in certain areas, or even the relative size of land and water, I would respond that the points I'm about to make will be stronger if there are significant differences from the current layout of the earth's surface. For instance, if, under the same conditions, land is more fragmented into islands at one time than at another, it could lead to a more consistent climate, even with the average temperature remaining the same. Or, if in a different era there were mountains taller than the Himalayas, these would create much colder conditions when situated in high latitudes. Alternatively, if we assume that at certain times no range of hills in the world exceeded 10,000 feet, then it might have been warmer than what could exist with mountains three times that height.

However constant may be the relative proportion of sea and land, we know that there is annually some small variation in their respective geographical positions, and that in every century the land is in some parts raised, and in others depressed in level, and so likewise is the bed of the sea. By these and other ceaseless changes, the configuration of the earth's surface has been remodelled again and again, since it was the habitation of organic beings, and the bed of the ocean has been lifted up to the height of some of the loftiest mountains. The imagination is apt to take alarm when called upon to admit the formation of such irregularities in the crust of the earth, after it had once become the habitation of living creatures; but, if time be allowed, the operation need not subvert the ordinary repose of nature; and the result is in a general view insignificant, if we consider how slightly the highest mountain-chains cause our globe to differ from a perfect sphere. Chimborazo, though it rises to more than 21,000 feet above the sea, would be represented, on a globe of about six feet in diameter, by a grain of sand less than one-twentieth of an inch in thickness.

However constant the relative proportion of sea and land may be, we know that there are annual small variations in their geographical positions. In every century, some areas of land are raised while others are lowered, and the same is true for the sea floor. Through these and other ongoing changes, the earth's surface has been reshaped repeatedly since it became home to living organisms, and the ocean bed has been lifted to the heights of some of the tallest mountains. It’s easy for our imagination to be startled by the idea of such irregularities forming in the earth's crust after it has already hosted life. But if there's enough time, these processes don’t have to disrupt the normal balance of nature. When we look at it from a broader perspective, the impact is relatively minor, especially considering how little the highest mountain ranges affect the globe's overall shape compared to a perfect sphere. For example, Chimborazo, which rises over 21,000 feet above sea level, would appear as a grain of sand less than one-twentieth of an inch thick on a six-foot diameter globe.

The superficial inequalities of the earth, then, may be deemed minute in quantity, and their distribution at any particular epoch must be regarded in geology as temporary peculiarities, like the height and outline of the cone of Vesuvius in the interval between two eruptions. But although, in reference to the magnitude of the globe, the unevenness of the surface is so unimportant, it is on the position and direction of these small inequalities that the state of the atmosphere, and both the local and general climate, are mainly dependent.

The small surface inequalities of the Earth can be considered minor in scale, and their arrangement at any given time should be viewed in geology as temporary features, similar to the height and shape of Vesuvius between eruptions. However, even though the unevenness of the surface is trivial in relation to the size of the planet, the specific locations and orientations of these minor inequalities significantly influence the atmosphere's condition and both local and overall climate.

Before considering the effect which a material change in the distribution of land and sea must occasion, it may be well to remark, how greatly organic life may be affected by those minor variations, which need not in the least degree alter the general temperature. Thus, for example, if we suppose, by a series of convulsions, a certain part of Greenland to become sea, and, in compensation, a tract of land to rise and connect Spitzbergen with Lapland,—an accession not greater in amount than one which the geologist can prove to have occurred in certain districts bordering the Mediterranean, within a comparatively modern period,—this altered form of the land might cause an interchange between the climate of certain parts of North America and of Europe, which lie in corresponding latitudes. Many European species of plants and animals would probably perish in consequence, because the mean temperature would be greatly lowered; and others would fail in America, because it would there be raised. On the other hand, in places where the mean annual heat remained unaltered, some species which flourish in Europe, where the seasons are more uniform, would be unable to resist the greater heat of the North American summer, or the103 intenser cold of the winter; while others, now fitted by their habits for the great contrast of the American seasons, would not be fitted for the insular climate of Europe. The vine, for example, according to Humboldt, can be cultivated with advantage 10° farther north in Europe than in North America. Many plants endure severe frost, but cannot ripen their seeds without a certain intensity of summer heat and a certain quantity of light; others cannot endure a similar intensity either of heat or cold.

Before we think about how a significant change in the distribution of land and sea will affect things, it’s worth noting how much organic life can be influenced by smaller changes that don’t really impact the overall temperature. For example, if we imagine that through a series of geological events, a portion of Greenland becomes ocean, and an area of land rises to connect Spitzbergen with Lapland—something that isn't larger in scale than changes proven by geologists to have happened in certain Mediterranean regions not too long ago—this shift in land could result in a climate exchange between parts of North America and Europe that are at similar latitudes. Many plant and animal species from Europe might die out because the average temperature would drop significantly; conversely, some species would struggle in America due to a rise in temperature. In areas where the average annual temperature stays the same, certain species thriving in Europe, where seasons are more stable, wouldn’t cope with the higher heat of North American summers or the harsher cold of winters; meanwhile, other species adapted to the stark seasonal changes in America wouldn’t thrive in Europe’s more mild climate. For instance, according to Humboldt, the vine can grow more successfully 10° farther north in Europe than in North America. Many plants can withstand severe frost but need specific summer heat and light levels to mature their seeds; others can’t tolerate similar extremes of heat or cold.

It is now established that many of the existing species of animals have survived great changes in the physical geography of the globe. If such species be termed modern, in comparison to races which preceded them, their remains, nevertheless, enter into submarine deposits many hundred miles in length, and which have since been raised from the deep to no inconsiderable altitude. When, therefore, it is shown that changes in the temperature of the atmosphere may be the consequence of such physical revolutions of the surface, we ought no longer to wonder that we find the distribution of existing species to be local, in regard to longitude as well as latitude. If all species were now, by an exertion of creative power, to be diffused uniformly throughout those zones where there is an equal degree of heat, and in all respects a similarity of climate, they would begin from this moment to depart more and more from their original distribution. Aquatic and terrestrial species would be displaced, as Hooke long ago observed, so often as land and water exchanged places; and there would also, by the formation of new mountains and other changes, be transpositions of climate, contributing, in the manner before alluded to, to the local extermination of species.184

It is now clear that many of the animal species we have today have withstood significant changes in the Earth's physical landscape. If we consider these species as modern compared to those that came before, their remains can still be found in underwater deposits stretching hundreds of miles, which have since been pushed up from the ocean floor to considerable heights. Therefore, when we see that shifts in atmospheric temperature can result from such physical changes to the Earth's surface, we shouldn’t be surprised that the distribution of today's species is local, in both longitude and latitude. If all species were to be spread evenly across regions with the same temperature and similar climates due to a creative force, they would immediately start to diverge from their original distribution. Aquatic and terrestrial species would be moved around, as Hooke noted long ago, every time land and water switched places; and with the creation of new mountains and other changes, climates would shift, leading to the local extinction of certain species, as previously mentioned.184

If we now proceed to consider the circumstances required for a general change of temperature, it will appear, from the facts and principles already laid down, that whenever a greater extent of high land is collected in the polar regions, the cold will augment; and the same result will be produced when there is more sea between or near the tropics; while, on the contrary, so often as the above conditions are reversed, the heat will be greater. (See figs. 5 and 6, p. 111.) If this be admitted, it will follow, that unless the superficial inequalities of the earth be fixed and permanent, there must be never-ending fluctuations in the mean temperature of every zone; and that the climate of one era can no more be a type of every other; than is one of our four seasons of all the rest.

If we now look at the conditions needed for a general change in temperature, it will become clear, based on the facts and principles already discussed, that whenever a larger area of high land is found in the polar regions, the cold will increase. The same effect will happen when there is more sea between or near the tropics. Conversely, whenever these conditions are reversed, the heat will be higher. (See figs. 5 and 6, p. 111.) If this is accepted, it follows that unless the surface characteristics of the earth are fixed and permanent, there will be constant fluctuations in the average temperature of every zone; and that the climate of one era can't serve as a representative for all others, just like one of our four seasons doesn't represent the others.

It has been well said, that the earth is covered by an ocean, in the midst of which are two great islands, and many smaller ones; for the whole of the continents and islands occupy an area scarcely exceeding one-fourth of the whole superficies of the spheroid. Now, according to this analogy, we may fairly speculate on the probability that there would not be usually, at any given epoch of the past, more than about one-fourth dry land in a particular region; as, for example, near the poles, 104 or between them and the 75th parallels of N. and S. latitude. If, therefore, at present there should happen to be, in both these quarters of the globe, much more than this average proportion of land, some of it in the arctic region, being above, five thousand feet in height, and if in antarctic latitudes a mountainous country has been found varying from 4000 to 14,000 feet in height, this alone affords ground for concluding that, in the present state of things, the mean heat of the climate is below that which the earth's surface, in its more ordinary state, would enjoy. This presumption is heightened when we reflect on the results of the recent soundings made by Sir James Ross, in the Southern Ocean, and continued for four successive years, ending 1844, which seem to prove that the mean depth of the Atlantic and Pacific is as great as Laplace and other eminent astronomers had imagined;185 for then we might look not only for more than two-thirds sea in the frigid zones, but for water of great depth, which could not readily be reduced to the freezing point. The same opinion is confirmed, when we compare the quantity of land lying between the poles and the 30th parallels of north and south latitude, with the quantity placed between those parallels and the equator; for, it is clear, that we have at present not only more than the usual degree of cold in the polar regions, but also less than the average quantity of heat within the tropics.

It has been said that the earth is covered by an ocean, in which there are two large islands and many smaller ones; the continents and islands make up only about one-fourth of the total surface of the earth. Based on this analogy, we can reasonably speculate that there wouldn't typically be more than about one-fourth of the land dry in any given area of the past; for example, near the poles or between them and the 75th parallels of latitude. So, if right now in these areas of the globe there is a lot more land than this average, with some in the Arctic being over five thousand feet high, and if there is a mountainous region in the Antarctic that ranges from 4000 to 14,000 feet high, this suggests that the average climate temperature is lower than what the earth's surface would usually experience. This assumption is strengthened when we consider the findings from recent soundings conducted by Sir James Ross in the Southern Ocean, which lasted for four consecutive years, ending in 1844, and seem to confirm that the average depth of the Atlantic and Pacific is as deep as Laplace and other notable astronomers thought; for then we would expect to find more than two-thirds of the area in the frigid zones to be sea, with water significantly deep enough that it wouldn't easily freeze. This point is further supported when we compare the amount of land between the poles and the 30th parallels of latitude north and south with the amount found between those parallels and the equator; it is clear that we are experiencing not only more extreme cold in the polar regions but also less than the average heat in the tropics.

105Position of land and sea which might produce the extreme of cold of which the earth's surface is susceptible.—To simplify our view of the various changes in climate, which different combinations of geographical circumstances may produce, we shall first consider the conditions necessary for bringing about the extreme of cold, or what would have been termed in the language of the old writers the winter of the "great year," or geological cycle, and afterwards, the conditions requisite to produce the maximum of heat, or the summer of the same year.

105The arrangement of land and sea that could lead to the most intense cold that the Earth's surface can experience.—To make it easier to understand the different climate changes that various geographical combinations can bring about, we will first look at the conditions needed to create the most extreme cold, or what would have been referred to in older texts as the winter of the "great year," or geological cycle, and then we’ll discuss the conditions required to generate the highest heat, or the summer of that same year.

To begin with the northern hemisphere. Let us suppose those hills of the Italian peninsula and of Sicily, which are of comparatively modern origin, and contain many fossil shells identical with living species, to subside again into the sea, from which they have been raised, and that an extent of land of equal area and height (varying from one to three thousand feet) should rise up in the Arctic Ocean between Siberia and the north pole. In speaking of such changes, I shall not allude to the manner in which I conceive it possible that they may be brought about, nor of the time required for their accomplishment—reserving for a future occasion, not only the proofs that revolutions of equal magnitude have taken place, but that analogous operations are still in gradual progress. The alteration now supposed in the physical geography of the northern regions, would cause additional snow and ice to accumulate where now there is usually an open sea; and the temperature of the greater part of Europe would be somewhat lowered, so as to resemble more nearly that of corresponding latitudes of North America: or, in other words, it might be necessary to travel about 10° farther south in order to meet with the same climate which we now enjoy. No compensation would be derived from the disappearance of land in the Mediterranean countries; but the contrary, since the mean heat of the soil in those latitudes probably exceeds that which would belong to the sea, by which we imagine it to be replaced.

To start with the northern hemisphere, let’s imagine that the hills of the Italian peninsula and Sicily, which are relatively new in geological terms and have many fossil shells that are the same as living species, sink back into the sea from which they originally rose. At the same time, an area of land with a similar size and height (ranging from one to three thousand feet) rises up in the Arctic Ocean between Siberia and the North Pole. I won’t discuss how I think these changes might happen or how long they would take—I'll leave that for another time, along with the evidence that similarly significant changes have occurred before and that such processes are still ongoing. The imagined change in the physical geography of the northern regions would lead to more snow and ice building up where there is usually open sea now, and the temperature across much of Europe would drop a bit, bringing it closer to the climate of similar latitudes in North America. In other words, you might have to travel about 10° farther south to find the same climate we enjoy today. The loss of land in the Mediterranean areas wouldn’t provide any benefit; in fact, the opposite would likely be true, since the average temperature of the land there probably exceeds that of the sea that would take its place.

But let the configuration of the surface be still farther varied, and let some large district within or near the tropics, such as Brazil, with its plains and hills of moderate height, be converted into sea, while lands of equal elevation and extent rise up in the arctic circle. From this change there would, in the first place, result a sensible diminution of temperature near the tropic, for the Brazilian soil would no longer be heated by the sun; so that the atmosphere would be less warm, as also the neighboring Atlantic. On the other hand, the whole of Europe, Northern Asia, and North America, would be chilled by the enormous quantity of ice and snow, thus generated on the new arctic continent. If, as we have already seen, there are now some points in the southern hemisphere where snow is perpetual down to the level of the sea, in latitudes as low as central England, such might assuredly be the case throughout a great part of Europe, under the change of circumstances above supposed: and if at present the extreme range of drifted icebergs is the Azores, they might easily reach the equator after the assumed alteration. But to pursue the subject still farther, let the Himalaya106 mountains, with the whole of Hindostan, sink down, and their place be occupied by the Indian Ocean, while an equal extent of territory and mountains, of the same vast height, rise up between North Greenland and the Orkney Islands. It seems difficult to exaggerate the amount to which the climate of the northern hemisphere would then be cooled.186

But let's change the layout of the land even more, and imagine a large area within or near the tropics, like Brazil, with its plains and moderately high hills, turning into ocean, while equal areas of land and height pop up in the Arctic Circle. This switch would first lead to a noticeable drop in temperature near the tropics, because the Brazilian ground wouldn't be warmed by the sun anymore; thus, the atmosphere and the nearby Atlantic would also cool down. Meanwhile, Europe, Northern Asia, and North America would be chilled by the vast amount of ice and snow generated on the new Arctic continent. If we consider that there are already places in the southern hemisphere where snow is permanent down to sea level, even at latitudes as low as central England, this could definitely happen across much of Europe under the circumstances we just described. And if the current farthest reach of drifting icebergs is around the Azores, they could easily reach the equator after this shift. Continuing this thought, imagine the Himalayas, along with all of Hindostan, sinking down and being replaced by the Indian Ocean, while an equivalent area of land and equally towering mountains rises up between North Greenland and the Orkney Islands. It seems hard to overstate just how much cooler the climate of the northern hemisphere would be then.186

But the refrigeration brought about at the same time in the southern hemisphere, would be nearly equal, and the difference of temperature between the arctic and equatorial latitudes would not be much greater than at present; for no important disturbance can occur in the climate of a particular region without its immediately affecting all other latitudes, however remote. The heat and cold which surround the globe are in a state of constant and universal flux and reflux. The heated and rarefied air is always rising and flowing from the equator towards the poles in the higher regions of the atmosphere; while in the lower, the colder air is flowing back to restore the equilibrium. That this circulation is constantly going on in the aerial currents is not disputed; it is often proved by the opposite course of the clouds at different heights, and the fact has been farther illustrated in a striking manner by two recent events. The trade wind continually blows with great force from the island of Barbadoes to that of St. Vincent; notwithstanding which, during the eruption of the volcano in the island of St. Vincent, in 1812, ashes fell in profusion from a great height in the atmosphere upon Barbadoes.187 In like manner, during the great eruption of Sumbawa, in 1815, ashes were carried to the islands of Amboyna and Banda, which last is about 800 miles east from the site of the volcano. Yet the southeast monsoon was then at its height.188 This apparent transposition of matter against the wind, confirmed the opinion of the existence of a counter-current in the higher regions, which had previously rested on theoretical conclusions only.

But the cooling happening at the same time in the southern hemisphere would be pretty much equal, and the temperature difference between the Arctic and equatorial regions wouldn’t be much more significant than it is now; because no major change can occur in the climate of a specific area without instantly impacting all other latitudes, no matter how far apart they are. The heat and cold surrounding the Earth are constantly in a state of flux. Warm and lighter air is always rising and moving from the equator towards the poles in the upper atmosphere, while in the lower layers, the colder air flows back to restore balance. The ongoing circulation in the air currents is widely accepted; it’s often demonstrated by the opposing directions of clouds at different altitudes, and this has been further illustrated by two recent events. The trade winds consistently blow strongly from Barbados to St. Vincent; however, during the volcanic eruption on St. Vincent in 1812, ashes fell heavily from a high altitude in the atmosphere onto Barbados.187 Similarly, during the massive eruption of Sumbawa in 1815, ashes were carried to the islands of Amboyna and Banda, which is about 800 miles east of the volcano's location. Yet, the southeast monsoon was at its peak at that time.188 This apparent movement of matter against the wind reinforced the belief in a counter-current in the upper atmosphere, which had previously been based only on theoretical conclusions.

That a corresponding interchange takes place in the seas, is demonstrated, according to Humboldt, by the cold which is found to exist at great depths within the tropics; and, among other proofs, may be mentioned the mass of warmer water which the Gulf stream is constantly bearing northwards, while a cooler current flows from the north along the coast of Greenland and Labrador, and helps to restore the equilibrium.189

That a similar exchange happens in the oceans is shown, according to Humboldt, by the cold water found at great depths in the tropics. Among other evidence, we can point to the large amount of warmer water the Gulf Stream continually transports north, while a cooler current moves from the north along the coast of Greenland and Labrador, helping to restore balance.189

107Currents of colder and therefore specifically heavier water pass from the poles towards the equator, which cool the inferior parts of the ocean; so that the heat of the torrid zone and the cold of the polar circle balance each other. The refrigeration, therefore, of the polar regions, resulting from the supposed alteration in the distribution of land and sea, would be immediately communicated to the tropics, and from them its influence would extend to the antarctic circle, where the atmosphere and the ocean would be cooled, so that ice and snow would augment. Although the mean temperature of higher latitudes in the southern hemisphere is, as before stated, for the most part, lower than that of the same parallels in the northern, yet, for a considerable space on each side of the line, the mean annual heat of the waters is found to be the same in corresponding parallels. If, therefore, by the new position of the land, the formation of icebergs had become of common occurrence in the northern temperate zone, and if these were frequently drifted as far as the equator, the same degree of cold which they generated would immediately be communicated as far as the tropic of Capricorn, and from thence to the lands or ocean to the south.

107Colder, denser water flows from the poles toward the equator, cooling the deeper parts of the ocean. This creates a balance between the heat of the tropical region and the cold of the polar areas. Therefore, the cooling of the polar regions, due to the assumed change in the distribution of land and sea, would quickly affect the tropics, extending its impact to the Antarctic region where both the atmosphere and ocean would cool, leading to an increase in ice and snow. Although the average temperature in higher latitudes of the southern hemisphere is generally lower than in corresponding northern latitudes, for significant areas on either side of the equator, the average annual temperature of the waters is similar in equivalent latitudes. If the new land arrangement led to frequent iceberg formation in the northern temperate zone, and if these icebergs were often carried all the way to the equator, the degree of cold they produced would quickly spread to the tropic of Capricorn and then influence the surrounding lands or ocean to the south.

The freedom, then, of the circulation of heat and cold from pole to pole being duly considered, it will be evident that the mean temperature which may prevail at the same point at two distinct periods, may differ far more widely than that of any two points in the same parallels of latitude, at one and the same period. For the range of temperature, or in other words, the curvature of the isothermal lines in a given zone, and at a given period, must always be circumscribed within narrow limits, the climate of each place in that zone being controlled by the combined influence of the geographical peculiarities of all other parts of the earth. Whereas, if we compare the state of things at two distinct and somewhat distant epochs, a particular zone may at one time be under the influence of one class of disturbing causes, and at another time may be affected by an opposite combination. The lands, for example, to the north of Greenland cause the present climate of North America to be colder than that of Europe in the same latitudes; but the excess of cold is not so great as it would have been if the western hemisphere had been entirely isolated, or separated from the eastern like a distinct planet. For not only does the refrigeration produced by Greenland chill to a certain extent the atmosphere of northern and western Europe, but the mild climate of Europe reacts also upon North America, and moderates the chilling influence of the adjoining polar lands.

Considering the movement of heat and cold from the poles, it's clear that the average temperature at the same location during two different times can vary much more than the temperatures at two locations within the same latitude during the same time. The range of temperature, or the shape of the isothermal lines in a specific area at a specific time, is always confined within narrow limits. The climate of each area in that region is influenced by the geographical characteristics of all other parts of the world. On the other hand, if we look at two different points in time, a specific region may be affected by one set of influencing factors at one time and by a completely different set at another. For example, the lands north of Greenland make the current climate of North America colder than that of Europe at the same latitudes; however, the cold isn't as extreme as it would have been if North and South America were completely isolated from Europe, like a separate planet. This is because the cooling effect from Greenland impacts the atmosphere in northern and western Europe, but at the same time, the mild climate of Europe also influences North America, helping to balance out the chilling effects from the nearby polar regions.

To return to the state of the earth after the changes above supposed, we must not omit to dwell on the important effects to which a wide expanse of perpetual snow would give rise. It is probable that nearly the whole sea, from the poles to the parallels of 45°, would be frozen over; for it is well known that the immediate proximity of land is not 108essential to the formation and increase of field ice, provided there be in some part of the same zone a sufficient quantity of glaciers generated on or near the land, to cool down the sea. Captain Scoresby, in his account of the arctic regions, observes, that when the sun's rays "fall upon the snow-clad surface of the ice or land, they are in a great measure reflected, without producing any material elevation of temperature; but when they impinge on the black exterior of a ship, the pitch on one side occasionally becomes fluid while ice is rapidly generated at the other."190

To think about the state of the earth after the supposed changes, we should focus on the significant effects that a large area of permanent snow would cause. It's likely that almost the entire sea, from the poles to about 45° latitude, would be frozen over; this is because it's well-known that being close to land isn't essential for the formation and growth of sea ice, as long as there are enough glaciers in some part of the zone to cool the ocean. Captain Scoresby, in his account of the Arctic regions, notes that when the sun's rays hit the snow-covered surface of the ice or land, they are mostly reflected, without significantly raising the temperature; however, when the rays hit the dark surface of a ship, the pitch on one side can melt while ice rapidly forms on the other. 108190

Now field ice is almost always covered with snow;191 and thus not only land as extensive as our existing continents, but immense tracts of sea in the frigid and temperate zones, might present a solid surface covered with snow, and reflecting the sun's rays for the greater part of the year. Within the tropics, moreover, where the ocean now predominates, the sky would no longer be serene and clear, as in the present era; but masses of floating ice would cause quick condensations of vapor, so that fogs and clouds would deprive the vertical rays of the sun of half their power. The whole planet, therefore, would receive annually a smaller portion of the solar influence, and the external crust would part, by radiation, with some of the heat which had been accumulated in it, during a different state of the surface. This heat would be dissipated in the spaces surrounding our atmosphere, which, according to the calculations of M. Fourier, have a temperature much inferior to that of freezing water.

Now, field ice is almost always covered with snow;191 and so not only land as vast as our current continents but also huge areas of sea in the cold and temperate zones could provide a solid surface covered with snow, reflecting the sun's rays for most of the year. In the tropics, where the ocean currently dominates, the sky would no longer be calm and clear like it is today; instead, masses of floating ice would lead to quick condensation of vapor, resulting in fogs and clouds that would block half of the sun’s direct rays. Consequently, the entire planet would receive a smaller amount of solar energy each year, and the outer crust would lose some of the heat it had stored during a different state of the surface through radiation. This heat would dissipate into the areas surrounding our atmosphere, which, according to M. Fourier's calculations, are much cooler than freezing water.

After the geographical revolution above assumed, the climate of equinoctial lands might be brought at last to resemble that of the present temperate zone, or perhaps be far more wintry. They who should then inhabit such small isles and coral reefs as are now seen in the Indian Ocean and South Pacific, would wonder that zoophytes of large dimensions had once been so prolific in their seas; or if, perchance, they found the wood and fruit of the cocoa-nut tree or the palm silicified by the waters of some ancient mineral spring, or incrusted with calcareous matter, they would muse on the revolutions which had annihilated such genera, and replaced them by the oak, the chestnut, and the pine. With equal admiration would they compare the skeletons of their small lizards with the bones of fossil alligators and crocodiles more than twenty feet in length, which, at a former epoch, had multiplied between the tropics: and when they saw a pine included in an iceberg, drifted from latitudes which we now call temperate, they would be astonished at the proof thus afforded, that forests had once grown where nothing could be seen in their own times but a wilderness of snow.

After the geographical changes we mentioned earlier, the climate of equatorial lands might eventually look like that of today’s temperate zone, or maybe it would be even colder. People living on the small islands and coral reefs found in the Indian Ocean and South Pacific would be amazed that large zoophytes used to thrive in their waters. If they stumbled upon wood and fruit from the coconut tree or palm that had turned to stone from ancient mineral springs or were covered in lime, they would reflect on the changes that wiped out those species and allowed oaks, chestnuts, and pines to take their place. They would equally marvel at the bones of small lizards compared to fossils of alligators and crocodiles that were over twenty feet long, which once filled the tropics: and when they saw a pine tree trapped in an iceberg drifting from what we now call temperate regions, they would be shocked by the evidence that forests had once thrived where now they could only see a frozen wasteland.

If the reader hesitate to suppose so extensive an alteration of temperature as the probable consequence of geographical changes, confined to one hemisphere, he should remember how great are the local anomalies in climate now resulting from the peculiar distribution of land and sea 109in certain regions. Thus, in the island of South Georgia, before mentioned (p. 98), Captain Cook found the everlasting snows descending to the level of the sea, between lat. 54° and 55° S.; no trees or shrubs were to be seen, and in summer a few rocks only, after a partial melting of the ice and snow, were scantily covered with moss and tufts of grass. If such a climate can now exist at the level of the sea in a latitude corresponding to that of Yorkshire in spite of all those equalizing causes before enumerated, by which the mixture of the temperatures of distant regions is facilitated throughout the globe, what rigors might we not anticipate in a winter generated by the transfer of the mountains of India to our arctic circle!

If the reader hesitates to believe that such a significant change in temperature could be the likely result of geographical changes limited to one hemisphere, they should keep in mind the considerable local climate anomalies caused by the unique distribution of land and sea 109 in certain areas. For instance, in the island of South Georgia, as mentioned earlier (p. 98), Captain Cook discovered that the perpetual snows reached sea level between lat. 54° and 55° S.; there were no trees or shrubs visible, and during the summer, after some melting of the ice and snow, only a few rocks were sparsely covered with moss and clumps of grass. If such a climate can currently exist at sea level in a latitude similar to that of Yorkshire, despite all the equalizing factors previously mentioned that help mix temperatures from different regions around the world, what extreme conditions might we expect in a winter brought on by moving the mountains of India to our Arctic Circle!

But we have still to contemplate the additional refrigeration which might be effected by changes in the relative position of land and sea in the southern hemisphere. If the remaining continents were transferred from the equatorial and contiguous latitudes to the south polar regions, the intensity of cold produced might, perhaps, render the globe uninhabitable. We are too ignorant of the laws governing the direction of subterranean forces, to determine whether such a crisis be within the limits of possibility. At the same time, it may be observed, that no distribution of land can well be imagined more irregular, or, as it were, capricious, than that which now prevails; for at present, the globe may be divided into two equal parts, in such a manner, that one hemisphere shall be almost entirely covered with water, while the other shall contain less water than land (see figs. 3 and 4);192 and, what is still more extraordinary, on comparing the extratropical lands in the northern and southern hemispheres, the lands in the northern are found to be to those in the southern in the proportion of thirteen to one!193 To imagine all the lands, therefore, in high, and all the sea in low latitudes, as delineated in fig. 6. p. 111, would scarcely be a more anomalous state of the surface.

But we still need to think about the extra cooling that could happen if the positions of land and sea changed in the southern hemisphere. If the remaining continents moved from the equatorial and nearby latitudes to the south polar regions, the level of cold produced might make the Earth unlivable. We don’t understand enough about the forces underground to know if such a scenario is even possible. At the same time, it’s worth noting that it’s hard to imagine a distribution of land that is more irregular or seemingly random than what we have now; because right now, the globe can be split into two equal halves, with one hemisphere almost completely covered in water, while the other has more land than water (see figs. 3 and 4);192 and, even more remarkably, when comparing the lands in the northern and southern hemispheres outside the tropics, the lands in the north are found to outnumber those in the south by a ratio of thirteen to one!193 So, imagining all of the lands at high latitudes and all of the seas at low latitudes, as shown in fig. 6. p. 111, would hardly be a more unusual state of the surface.

Map showing the present unequal Distribution of Property and Water on the Surface of the World.
Fig. 3.
Map showing the present unequal Distribution of Land and Water.
Fig. 4.
Map showing the present unequal Distribution of Land and Water.

Fig. 3. Here London is taken as a centre, and we behold the greatest quantity of land existing in one hemisphere.

Fig. 3. Here, London is considered a center, and we observe the largest amount of land found in one hemisphere.

Fig. 4. Here the centre is the antipodal point to London, and we see the greatest quantity of water existing in one hemisphere.

Fig. 4. Here, the center is the opposite point to London, and we see the largest amount of water in one hemisphere.

The black shading expresses land having land opposite or antipodal to it.

The black shading represents land that is opposite or directly across from it.


Maps showing the position of Ground and Ocean which might produce the Extremes of Heat and Chilly in the Climates of the World.
Fig. 5.Map showing the present unequal Distribution of Land and Water.

Extreme of Heat.

Extreme Heat.

Fig. 6.Map showing the present unequal Distribution of Land and Water.

Extreme of Cold.

Extreme Cold.

Observations.—These maps are intended to show that continents and islands having the same shape and relative dimensions as those now existing, might be placed so as to occupy either the equatorial or polar regions.

Observations.—These maps are designed to demonstrate that continents and islands with shapes and sizes similar to those we have today could be arranged to take up space in either the equatorial or polar areas.

In fig. 5, scarcely any of the land extends from the equator towards the poles beyond the 30th parallel of latitude; and fig. 6, a very small proportion of it extends from the poles towards the Equator beyond the 40th parallel of latitude.

In fig. 5, almost none of the land stretches from the equator to the poles past the 30th parallel of latitude; and fig. 6, only a tiny fraction of it extends from the poles toward the equator beyond the 40th parallel of latitude.

Position of land and sea which might give rise to the extreme of heat.—Let us now turn from the contemplation of the winter of the "great year," and consider the opposite train of circumstances which would bring on the spring and summer. To imagine all the lands to be collected together in equatorial latitudes, and a few promontories only to project 112 beyond the thirtieth parallel, as represented in the annexed maps (figs. 5 and 6), would be undoubtedly to suppose an extreme result of geological change. But if we consider a mere approximation to such a state of things, it would be sufficient to cause a general elevation of temperature. Nor can it be regarded as a visionary idea, that amidst the revolutions of the earth's surface, the quantity of land should, at certain periods, have been simultaneously lessened in the vicinity of both the poles, and increased within the tropics. We must recollect that even now it is necessary to ascend to the height of fifteen thousand feet in the Andes under the line, and in the Himalaya mountains, which are without the tropic, to seventeen thousand feet, before we reach the limit of perpetual snow. On the northern slope, indeed, of the Himalaya range, where the heat radiated from a great continent moderates the cold, there are meadows and cultivated land at an elevation equal to the height of Mont Blanc.194 If then there were no arctic lands to chill the atmosphere, and freeze the sea, and if the loftiest chains were near the line, it seems reasonable to imagine that the highest mountains might be clothed with a rich vegetation to their summits, and that nearly all signs of frost would disappear from the earth.

Position of land and sea that could lead to extreme heat.—Now, let's shift our focus from the winter of the "great year" to the opposite conditions that would usher in spring and summer. If we were to picture all land masses gathered around the equator, with only a few peninsulas extending beyond the thirtieth parallel, as shown in the attached maps (figs. 5 and 6), it would certainly suggest an extreme geological change. However, even a slight approximation of such a scenario could significantly raise the overall temperature. It's not far-fetched to think that, throughout Earth's geological history, the amount of land near the poles has decreased while it increased in the tropics during certain times. We should remember that even today, you have to climb to about fifteen thousand feet in the Andes at the equator and to seventeen thousand feet in the Himalayas, which are outside the tropics, to reach the line of permanent snow. On the northern side of the Himalayas, where warmth from a large continent eases the cold, there are meadows and farmland at elevations equal to that of Mont Blanc. 194 Therefore, if there were no polar lands to cool the atmosphere and freeze the sea, and if the highest mountain ranges were near the equator, it makes sense to think that the tallest peaks could be covered in lush vegetation right up to their summits, with almost no signs of frost remaining on Earth.

When the absorption of the solar rays was in no region impeded, even in winter, by a coat of snow, the mean heat of the earth's crust would augment to considerable depths, and springs, which we know to be in general an index of the mean temperature of the climate, would be warmer in all latitudes. The waters of lakes, therefore, and rivers, would be much hotter in winter, and would be never chilled in summer by melted snow and ice. A remarkable uniformity of climate would prevail amid the archipelagoes of the temperate and polar oceans, where the tepid waters of equatorial currents would freely circulate. The general humidity of the atmosphere would far exceed that of the present period, for increased heat would promote evaporation in all parts of the globe. The winds would be first heated in their passage over the tropical plains, and would then gather moisture from the surface of the deep, till, charged with vapor, they arrived at extreme northern and southern regions, and there encountering a cooler atmosphere, discharged their burden in warm rain. If, during the long night of a polar winter, the snows should whiten the summits of some arctic islands, they would be dissolved as rapidly by the returning sun, as are the snows of Etna by the blasts of the sirocco.

When the sun's rays weren't blocked by snow at any point, even in winter, the average temperature of the Earth's crust would increase significantly at great depths, and springs, which generally indicate the average climate temperature, would be warmer in all regions. Consequently, the waters of lakes and rivers would be much warmer in winter and wouldn't be cooled in summer by melting snow and ice. A remarkable consistency in climate would exist among the temperate and polar oceans, where warm waters from equatorial currents would circulate freely. The overall humidity in the atmosphere would be much higher than it is today, as the increased heat would enhance evaporation everywhere on Earth. Winds would first warm up as they passed over the tropical plains, then pick up moisture from the ocean surface until they reached the extreme northern and southern areas, where they would encounter cooler air and release their moisture as warm rain. If the snow were to cover the peaks of some Arctic islands during the long polar night, it would melt as quickly when the sun returned, just like the snow on Etna does when the sirocco winds blow.

We learn from those who have studied the geographical distribution of plants, that in very low latitudes, at present, the vegetation of small islands remote from continents has a peculiar character; the ferns and allied families, in particular, bearing a great proportion to the total number of other plants. Other circumstances being the same, the more remote the isles are from the continents, the greater does this proportion become. Thus, in the continent of India, and the tropical parts of New Holland, the proportion of ferns to the phænogamous plants is only as one to twenty-six; whereas, in the South-Sea Islands, it is as one to four, or even as one to three.195

We learn from those who have studied how plants are distributed geographically that in very low latitudes, the vegetation of small islands far from continents has a unique character. Ferns and related plants, in particular, make up a large percentage of the total number of other plants. When other conditions are similar, the farther the islands are from the continents, the higher this percentage becomes. For example, in India and the tropical regions of Australia, the ratio of ferns to flowering plants is just one to twenty-six; however, in the South Sea Islands, it rises to one to four, or even one to three.195

113We might expect, therefore, in the summer of the "great year," or cycle of climate, that there would be a predominance of tree ferns and plants allied to genera now called tropical, in the islands of the wide ocean, while many forms now confined to arctic and temperate regions, or only found near the equator on the summit of the loftiest mountains, would almost disappear from the earth. Then might those genera of animals return, of which the memorials are preserved in the ancient rocks of our continents. The pterodactyle might flit again through the air, the huge iguanodon reappear in the woods, and the ichthyosaurs swarm once more in the sea. Coral reefs might be prolonged again beyond the arctic circle, where the whale and the narwal now abound; and droves of turtles might begin again to wander through regions now tenanted by the walrus and the seal.

113We might expect that in the summer of the "great year," or climate cycle, there would be a lot of tree ferns and plants related to what we now call tropical species on the islands of the vast ocean, while many types currently found only in arctic and temperate areas, or just near the equator on the highest mountains, would nearly vanish from the planet. Then those animal groups, whose remains are found in the ancient rocks of our continents, might return. The pterodactyl could soar through the skies again, the massive iguanodon could roam the forests, and the ichthyosaurs could thrive once more in the seas. Coral reefs might expand again beyond the arctic circle, where the whale and the narwhal are now plentiful; and herds of turtles might begin to wander through areas currently occupied by the walrus and the seal.

But not to indulge too far in these speculations, I may observe, in conclusion, that however great, during the lapse of ages, may be the vicissitudes of temperature in every zone, it accords with this theory that the general climate should not experience any sensible change in the course of a few thousand years; because that period is insufficient to affect the leading features of the physical geography of the globe.

But without getting too caught up in these thoughts, I should note that no matter how much temperatures change over the ages in every region, this theory suggests that the overall climate shouldn't see any significant change over a span of a few thousand years. This timeframe is just not long enough to impact the main aspects of the earth's physical geography.

Notwithstanding the apparent uncertainty of the seasons, it is found that the mean temperature of particular localities is very constant, when observations made for a sufficient series of years are compared.

Despite the seeming unpredictability of the seasons, it's observed that the average temperature of specific places remains quite stable when data collected over a long period is compared.

Yet there must be exceptions to this rule; and even the labors of man have, by the drainage of lakes and marshes, and the felling of extensive forests, caused such changes in the atmosphere as greatly to raise our conception of the more important influence of those forces to which, in certain latitudes, even the existence of land or water, hill or valley, lake or sea, must be ascribed. If we possessed accurate information of the amount of local fluctuation in climate in the course of twenty centuries, it would often, undoubtedly, be considerable. Certain tracts, for example, on the coast of Holland and of England consisted of cultivated land in the time of the Romans, which the sea, by gradual encroachments, has at length occupied. Here, at least, a slight alteration has been effected; for neither the distribution of heat in the different seasons, nor the mean annual temperature of the atmosphere investing the sea, is precisely the same as that which rests upon the land.

Yet there must be exceptions to this rule; and even human activities, like draining lakes and marshes and cutting down large forests, have caused changes in the atmosphere that significantly elevate our understanding of the more crucial influences of those forces. In some regions, the existence of land or water, hills or valleys, lakes or seas can be attributed to these influences. If we had accurate data on the amount of local climate fluctuations over the past twenty centuries, it would often be quite significant. For instance, certain areas on the coasts of Holland and England were once cultivated land during Roman times, which the sea has gradually taken over. Here, at least, a slight change has occurred; because neither the distribution of heat in different seasons nor the average annual temperature of the atmosphere over the sea is exactly the same as that over the land.

In those countries, also, where earthquakes and volcanoes are in full activity, a much shorter period may produce a sensible variation. The climate of the great table-land of Malpais in Mexico, must differ materially from that which prevailed before the middle of the last century; for, since that time, six mountains, the highest of them rising sixteen hundred feet above the plateau, have been thrown up by volcanic eruptions. It is by the repetition of an indefinite number of such local revolutions, and by slow movements extending simultaneously over wider areas, as will be afterwards shown, that a general change of climate may finally be brought about.

In those countries where earthquakes and volcanoes are very active, a much shorter time can lead to noticeable changes. The climate of the large plateau of Malpais in Mexico has likely changed a lot since the mid-1800s; since then, six mountains, with the tallest reaching 1,600 feet above the plateau, have formed from volcanic eruptions. It is through the repeated occurrence of countless local changes, along with slow movements that affect larger areas at the same time, as will be shown later, that a general climate change can eventually happen.


CHAPTER VIII.

ON FORMER CHANGES IN PHYSICAL GEOGRAPHY AND CLIMATE.

Geographical features of the northern hemisphere, at the period of the oldest fossiliferous strata—State of the surface when the mountain limestone and coal were deposited—Changes in physical geography, between the carboniferous period and the chalk—Abrupt transition from the secondary to the tertiary fossils—Accession of land, and elevation of mountain chains, after the consolidation of the secondary rocks—Explanation of Map, showing the area covered by sea, since the commencement of the tertiary period—Astronomical theories of the causes of variations in climate—Theory of the diminution of the supposed primitive heat of the globe.

Geographical features of the northern hemisphere during the time of the oldest fossil-bearing layers—The state of the surface when limestone and coal were formed—Changes in physical geography from the carboniferous period to the chalk—The sudden shift from secondary to tertiary fossils—The rise of land and formation of mountain ranges after the secondary rocks solidified—Explanation of the map showing the area that has been underwater since the start of the tertiary period—Astronomical theories about the causes of climate changes—Theory about the decrease of the supposed original heat of the Earth.

In the sixth chapter, I stated the arguments derived from organic remains for concluding that in the period when the carboniferous strata were deposited, the temperature of the ocean and the air was more uniform in the different seasons of the year, and in different latitudes, than at present, and that there was a remarkable absence of cold as well as great moisture in the atmosphere. It was also shown that the climate had been modified more than once since that epoch, and that it had been reduced, by successive changes, more and more nearly to that now prevailing in the same latitudes. Farther, I endeavored, in the last chapter, to prove that vicissitudes in climate of no less importance may be expected to recur in future, if it be admitted that causes now active in nature have power, in the lapse of ages, to produce considerable variations in the relative position of land and sea. It remains to inquire whether the alterations, which the geologist can prove to have actually taken place at former periods, in the geographical features of the northern hemisphere, coincide in their nature, and in the time of their occurrence, with such revolutions in climate as might naturally have resulted, according to the meteorological principles already explained.

In the sixth chapter, I discussed the evidence from organic remains suggesting that during the time the carboniferous layers were laid down, the temperature of the ocean and the air was more consistent across different seasons and latitudes than it is today. Additionally, there was a significant lack of cold and a lot of moisture in the atmosphere. It was also shown that the climate had changed multiple times since that period and that it has gradually shifted closer to the current conditions in those same latitudes. Furthermore, in the last chapter, I aimed to show that significant climate changes can be expected to happen again in the future if we accept that the active forces in nature can cause substantial alterations over long periods. We now need to investigate whether the changes that geologists can demonstrate have actually taken place in the geographical features of the northern hemisphere align in nature and timing with the climate shifts that would naturally have resulted from the meteorological principles already discussed.

Period of the primary fossiliferous rocks.—The oldest system of strata which afford by their organic remains any evidence as to climate, or the former position of land and sea, are those formerly known as the transition rocks, or what have since been termed Lower Silurian or "primary fossiliferous" formations. These have been found in England, France, Germany, Sweden, Russia, and other parts of central and northern Europe, as also in the great Lake district of Canada and the United States. The multilocular or chambered univalves, including the Nautilus, and the corals, obtained from the limestones of these ancient groups, have been compared to forms now most largely developed in tropical seas. The corals, however, have been shown by M. Milne Edwards to differ generally from all living zoophytes; so that conclusions as to a warmer climate drawn from such remote analogies must be received with 115 caution. Hitherto, few, if any, contemporaneous vegetable remains have been noticed; but such as are mentioned agree more nearly with the plants of the carboniferous era than any other, and would therefore imply a warm and humid atmosphere entirely free from intense cold throughout the year.

Period of the primary fossiliferous rocks.—The oldest layers of rock that provide any evidence of climate or the past arrangement of land and sea are what were once called the transition rocks, now referred to as Lower Silurian or "primary fossiliferous" formations. These have been discovered in England, France, Germany, Sweden, Russia, and other regions of central and northern Europe, as well as in the major Lake district of Canada and the United States. The multilocular or chambered univalves, including the Nautilus, and the corals found in the limestones of these ancient groups have been likened to forms that are most prevalent in tropical seas today. However, M. Milne Edwards has shown that these corals generally differ from all living zoophytes; therefore, any conclusions about a warmer climate drawn from such distant comparisons should be taken with 115 caution. So far, few, if any, contemporary plant remains have been identified; but the ones that have been noted are more closely related to the plants of the carboniferous period than to any others, suggesting a warm and humid atmosphere completely free from intense cold throughout the year.

This absence or great scarcity of plants as well as of freshwater shells and other indications of neighboring land, coupled with the wide extent of marine strata of this age in Europe and North America, are facts which imply such a state of physical geography (so far at least as regards the northern hemisphere) as would, according to the principles before explained, give rise to such a moist and equable climate. (See p. 109, and fig. 5, p. 111.)

This lack or significant scarcity of plants, along with the freshwater shells and other signs of nearby land, combined with the vast marine layers from this period in Europe and North America, suggest a situation in physical geography (at least in the northern hemisphere) that, according to the principles previously discussed, would lead to a moist and stable climate. (See p. 109, and fig. 5, p. 111.)

Carboniferous group.—This group comes next in the order of succession; and one of its principal members, the mountain limestone, was evidently a marine formation, as is shown by the shells and corals which it contains. That the ocean of that period was of considerable extent in our latitudes, we may infer from the continuity of these calcareous strata over large areas in Europe, Canada, and the United States. The same group has also been traced in North America, towards the borders of the arctic sea.196

Carboniferous group.—This group follows next in the sequence; and one of its main components, the mountain limestone, was clearly formed in a marine environment, as evidenced by the shells and corals it contains. We can infer that the ocean during that period covered a significant area in our latitudes from the continuous presence of these calcareous layers over large regions in Europe, Canada, and the United States. This same group has also been traced in North America, near the borders of the Arctic Sea.196

There are also several regions in Scotland, and in the central and northern parts of England, as well as in the United States, where marine carboniferous limestones alternate with strata containing coal, in such a manner as to imply the drifting down of plants by rivers into the sea, and the alternate occupation of the same space by fresh and salt water.

There are also several areas in Scotland, as well as in the central and northern parts of England and in the United States, where marine carboniferous limestones alternate with layers that contain coal. This suggests that plants were carried down by rivers into the sea, and that the same area was alternately occupied by fresh and salt water.

Since the time of the earlier writers, no strata have been more extensively investigated, both in Europe and North America, than those of the ancient carboniferous group, and the progress of science has led to a general belief that a large portion of the purest coal has been formed, not, as was once imagined, by vegetable matter floated from a distance, but by plants which grew on the spot, and somewhat in the manner of peat on the spaces now covered by the beds of coal. The former existence of land in some of these spaces has been proved, as already stated, by the occurrence of numerous upright fossil trees, with their roots terminating downwards in seams of coal; and still more generally by the roots of trees (stigmariæ) remaining in their natural position in the clays which underlie almost every layer of coal.

Since the days of earlier writers, no rock layers have been more thoroughly studied, both in Europe and North America, than those of the ancient carboniferous group. Advances in science have led to a widespread belief that a large part of the purest coal was not formed from plant material carried from afar, as was once thought, but from plants that actually grew in the area, similar to how peat forms in locations that are now coal beds. The past existence of land in some of these areas has been demonstrated, as mentioned earlier, by the discovery of numerous upright fossil trees, with their roots extending downward into coal seams; and even more commonly, by the roots of trees (stigmaria) remaining in their natural position within the clays that lie beneath almost every layer of coal.

As some nearly continuous beds of such coal have of late years been traced in North America, over areas 100 or 200 miles and upwards in diameter, it may be asked whether the large tracts of ancient land implied by this fact are not inconsistent with the hypothesis of the general prevalence of islands at the period under consideration? In reply, I may observe that the coal-fields must originally have been low alluvial grounds, resembling in situation the cypress-swamps of the Mississippi, or the sunderbunds of the Ganges, being liable like them to be inundated 116 at certain periods by a river or by the sea, if the land should be depressed a few feet. All the phenomena, organic and inorganic, imply conditions nowhere to be met with except in the deltas of large rivers. We have to account for an abundant supply of fluviatile sediment, carried for ages towards one and the same region, and capable of forming strata of mud and sand thousands of feet, or even fathoms, in thickness, many of them consisting of laminated shale, inclosing the leaves of ferns and other terrestrial plants. We have also to explain the frequent intercalations of root-beds, and the interposition here and there of brackish and marine deposits, demonstrating the occasional presence of the neighboring sea. But these forest-covered deltas could only have been formed at the termination of large hydrographical basins, each drained by a great river and its tributaries; and the accumulation of sediment bears testimony to contemporaneous denudation on a large scale, and, therefore, to a wide area of land, probably containing within it one or more mountain chains.

As recent discoveries have traced nearly continuous coal beds in North America, covering areas over 100 or 200 miles in diameter, one might wonder if the vast ancient land suggested by this fact contradicts the idea of widespread islands during that time. In response, I would note that the coal fields must have originally been low-lying floodplains, similar to the cypress swamps of the Mississippi or the Sundarbans of the Ganges, which were also susceptible to flooding by a river or the sea if the land sank a few feet. All the natural phenomena, both organic and inorganic, indicate conditions that can only be found in the deltas of large rivers. We need to account for a significant supply of river sediment that has been transported to the same area for ages, capable of creating layers of mud and sand thousands of feet thick, many of which consist of laminated shale that contains ferns and other land plants. It’s also necessary to explain the frequent layers of root beds and the occasional presence of brackish and marine deposits, which show that the neighboring sea was sometimes nearby. However, these forested deltas could only have formed at the end of large river basins, each drained by a major river and its tributaries; the buildup of sediment points to extensive erosion occurring at the same time, indicating a large land area, likely with one or more mountain ranges within it.

In the case of the great Ohio or Appalachian coal-field, the largest in the world, it seems clear that the uplands drained by one or more great rivers were chiefly to the eastward, or they occupied a space now filled by part of the Atlantic Ocean, for the mechanical deposits of mud and sand increase greatly in thickness and coarseness of material as we approach the eastern borders of the coal-field, or the southeast flanks of the Alleghany mountains, near Philadelphia. In that region numerous beds of pebbles, often of the size of a hen's egg, are seen to alternate with beds of pure coal.

In the case of the vast Ohio or Appalachian coalfield, the largest in the world, it’s clear that the highlands drained by one or more major rivers were mainly to the east, or they covered an area now occupied by part of the Atlantic Ocean. The deposits of mud and sand increase significantly in thickness and coarseness of material as we get closer to the eastern edges of the coalfield, particularly the southeast slopes of the Allegheny Mountains, near Philadelphia. In that area, many layers of pebbles, often the size of a hen's egg, can be seen alternating with layers of pure coal.

But the American coal-fields are all comprised within the 30th and 50th degrees of north latitude; and there is no reason to presume that the lands at the borders of which they originated ever penetrated so far or in such masses into the colder and arctic regions, so as to generate a cold climate. In the southern hemisphere, where the predominance of sea over land is now the distinguishing geographical feature, we nevertheless find a large part of the continent of Australia, as well as New Zealand, placed between the 30th and 50th degrees of S. latitude. The two islands of New Zealand taken together, are between 800 and 900 miles in length, with a breadth in some parts of ninety miles, and they stretch as far south as the 46th degree of latitude. They afford, therefore, a wide area for the growth of a terrestrial vegetation, and the botany of this region is characterized by abundance of ferns, one hundred and forty species of which are already known, some of them attaining the size of trees. In this respect the southern shores of New Zealand in the 46th degree of latitude almost vie with tropical islands. Another point of resemblance between the Flora of New Zealand and that of the ancient carboniferous period is the prevalence of the fir tribe or of coniferous wood.

But the American coal fields are all located between the 30th and 50th degrees of north latitude; and there's no reason to think that the lands from which they originated ever extended that far or in such large amounts into the colder, arctic regions to create a cold climate. In the southern hemisphere, where the abundance of sea compared to land is the main geographical feature, we still find a large portion of the continent of Australia, as well as New Zealand, situated between the 30th and 50th degrees of south latitude. The two islands of New Zealand combined are between 800 and 900 miles long, with some parts being ninety miles wide, and they extend as far south as the 46th degree of latitude. Therefore, they provide a large area for terrestrial vegetation, and the botany of this region is marked by a wealth of ferns, with one hundred and forty species already identified, some of which can grow as large as trees. In this regard, the southern shores of New Zealand at the 46th degree of latitude almost compete with tropical islands. Another similarity between the flora of New Zealand and that of the ancient carboniferous period is the predominance of the fir family or coniferous trees.

An argument of some weight in corroboration of the theory above explained respecting the geographical condition of the temperate and arctic latitudes of the northern hemisphere in the carboniferous period117 may also be derived from ah examination of those groups of strata which immediately preceded the coal. The fossils of the Devonian and Silurian strata in Europe and North America have led to the conclusion, that they were formed for the most part in deep seas, far from land. In those older strata land plants are almost as rare as they are abundant or universal in the coal measures. Those ancient deposits, therefore, may be supposed to have belonged to an epoch when dry land had only just begun to be upraised from the deep; a theory which would imply the existence during the carboniferous epoch of islands, instead of an extensive continent, in the area where the coal was formed.

A strong argument supporting the theory mentioned about the geographical conditions of the temperate and arctic regions in the northern hemisphere during the Carboniferous period117 can also be drawn from examining the groups of rock layers that directly preceded the coal. The fossils found in the Devonian and Silurian layers in Europe and North America suggest that they were mostly created in deep seas, away from land. In those older layers, land plants are nearly as rare as they are plentiful or widespread in the coal deposits. Therefore, these ancient deposits can be thought to belong to a time when dry land was only just starting to rise from the depths; a theory that would indicate the presence of islands, rather than a large continent, in the area where coal was formed during the Carboniferous period.

Such a state of things prevailing in the north, from the pole to the 30th parallel of latitude, if not neutralized by circumstances of a contrary tendency in corresponding regions south of the line, would give rise to a general warmth and uniformity of climate throughout the globe.

Such conditions in the north, from the pole to the 30th parallel of latitude, if not countered by opposing factors in similar areas south of the line, would lead to a general warmth and consistency in climate around the world.

Changes in physical geography between the formation of the carboniferous strata and the chalk.—We have evidence in England that the strata of the ancient carboniferous group, already adverted to, were, in many instances, fractured and contorted, and often thrown into a vertical position, before the deposition of some even of the oldest known secondary rocks, such as the new red sandstone.

Changes in physical geography between the formation of the carboniferous strata and the chalk.—We have evidence in England that the layers of the ancient carboniferous group, mentioned earlier, were often fractured and twisted, and frequently tilted into a vertical position, before the deposition of some of the earliest known secondary rocks, like the new red sandstone.

Fragments of the older formations are sometimes included in the conglomerates of the more modern; and some of these fragments still retain their fossil shells and corals, so as to enable us to determine the parent rocks from whence they were derived. There are other proofs of the disturbance at successive epochs of different secondary rocks before the deposition of others; and satisfactory evidence that, during these reiterated convulsions, the geographical features of the northern hemisphere were frequently modified, and that from time to time new lands emerged from the deep. The vegetation, during some parts of the period in question (from the lias to the chalk inclusive), when genera allied to Cycas and Zamia were abundant, appears to have approached to that of the larger islands of the equatorial zone; such, for example, as we now find in the West Indian archipelago.197 These islands appear to have been drained by rivers of considerable size, which were inhabited by crocodiles and gigantic oviparous reptiles, both herbivorous and carnivorous, belonging for the most part to extinct genera. Of the contemporary inhabitants of the land we have as yet acquired but scanty information, but we know that there were flying reptiles, insects, and small mammifers, allied to the marsupial tribes.

Fragments of older formations are sometimes found in the conglomerates of more modern rocks, and some of these fragments still have their fossil shells and corals, which help us identify the original rocks they came from. There are also other signs that different secondary rocks were disturbed at various times before other layers were deposited. This provides solid evidence that during these repeated upheavals, the geographical features of the northern hemisphere were often changed and that new land occasionally rose from the sea. The vegetation during some parts of this time (from the lias to the chalk, inclusive), when genera related to Cycas and Zamia were common, seems to have been similar to that found on the larger islands of the equatorial zone, like those in the West Indian archipelago.197 These islands seemed to have been drained by large rivers, which were home to crocodiles and giant egg-laying reptiles, both herbivorous and carnivorous, mostly from extinct genera. We don’t have much information about the contemporary land inhabitants yet, but we know that there were flying reptiles, insects, and small mammals related to marsupials.

A freshwater deposit, called the Wealden, occurs in the upper part of the secondary series of the south of England, which, by its extent and fossils, attests the existence in that region of a large river draining a continent or island of considerable dimensions. We know that this land was clothed with wood, and inhabited by huge terrestrial reptiles and birds. Its position so far to the north as the counties of Surrey and 118Sussex, at a time when the mean temperature of the climate is supposed to have been much hotter than at present, may at first sight appear inconsistent with the theory before explained, that the heat was caused by the gathering together of all the great masses of land in low latitudes, while the northern regions were almost entirely sea. But it must not be taken for granted that the geographical conditions already described (p. 109, and fig. 5, p. 111) as capable of producing the extreme of heat were ever combined at any geological period of which we have yet obtained information. It is more probable, from what has been stated in the preceding chapters, that a slight approximation to such an extreme state of things would be sufficient; in other words, if most of the dry land were tropical, and scarcely any of it arctic or antarctic, a prodigious elevation of temperature must ensue, even though a part of some continents should penetrate far into the temperate zones.

A freshwater deposit known as the Wealden is found in the upper part of the secondary geological series in southern England. Its size and the fossils within it indicate that there was once a large river draining a significant landmass, whether a continent or a sizable island. We know this land was covered in forests and populated by giant land reptiles and birds. Its location, as far north as the counties of Surrey and Sussex, during a time when the average temperature is thought to have been much warmer than today, might initially seem to contradict the previously mentioned theory that heat was generated by the clustering of major landmasses in low latitudes, while the northern areas were mostly ocean. However, we shouldn't assume that the geographical conditions described earlier (p. 109, and fig. 5, p. 111) that could lead to extremely high temperatures were ever combined during any geological period for which we have information. It is more likely, based on what has been discussed in the previous chapters, that a slight approach to such extreme conditions would suffice. In other words, if the majority of the dry land was tropical and only a small portion was arctic or antarctic, a significant rise in temperature would still occur, even if part of some continents extended far into the temperate zones.

Changes during the tertiary periods.—The secondary and tertiary formations of Europe, when considered separately, may be contrasted as having very different characters; the secondary appearing to have been deposited in open seas, the tertiary in regions where dry land, lakes, bays, and perhaps inland seas, abounded. The secondary series is almost exclusively marine; the tertiary, even the oldest part, contains lacustrine strata, and not unfrequently freshwater and marine beds alternating. In fact there is evidence of important geographical changes having occurred between the deposition of the cretaceous system, or uppermost of the secondary series, and that of the oldest tertiary group, and still more between the era of the latter and that of the newer tertiary formations. This change in the physical geography of Europe and North America was accompanied by an alteration no less remarkable in organic life, scarcely any species being common both to the secondary and tertiary rocks, and the fossils of the latter affording evidence of a different climate.

Changes during the tertiary periods.—The secondary and tertiary formations of Europe, when looked at separately, have very different characteristics; the secondary seems to have formed in open seas, while the tertiary was created in areas filled with dry land, lakes, bays, and possibly even inland seas. The secondary series is almost entirely marine; the tertiary, even at its oldest part, contains layers from lakes and often has freshwater and marine deposits alternating. In fact, there is evidence that significant geographical changes occurred between the deposition of the Cretaceous system, which is the top layer of the secondary series, and the oldest tertiary group, and even more so between that era and the newer tertiary formations. This change in the physical geography of Europe and North America was also marked by a significant shift in organic life, with hardly any species being common to both the secondary and tertiary rocks, and the fossils from the latter providing proof of a different climate.

On the other hand, when we compare the tertiary formations of successive ages, we trace a gradual approximation in the imbedded fossils, from an assemblage in which extinct species predominate, to one where the species agree for the most part with those now existing. In other words, we find a gradual increase of animals and plants fitted for our present climates, in proportion as the strata which we examine are more modern. Now, during all these successive tertiary periods, there are signs of a great increase of land in European and North American latitudes. By reference to the map (Pl. 1), and its description, p. 121. the reader will see that about two-thirds of the present European lands have emerged since the earliest tertiary group originated. Nor is this the only revolution which the same region has undergone within the period alluded to, some tracts which were previously land having gained in altitude, others, on the contrary, having sunk below their former level.

On the other hand, when we look at the tertiary formations from different time periods, we notice a gradual change in the fossils found within them, from a collection dominated by extinct species to one where the species mostly match those that exist today. In other words, we see a gradual increase in animals and plants that are adapted to our current climates, as we examine more recent layers of rock. Throughout these successive tertiary periods, there are signs of a significant increase in land in European and North American areas. By checking the map (Pl. 1) and its description, p. 121, you will see that about two-thirds of present-day European land has appeared since the earliest tertiary group first emerged. This region has also experienced other major changes during this time; some areas of land have risen in elevation, while others have sunk below their previous level.

That the existing lands were not all upheaved at once into their present position is proved by the most striking evidence. Several Italian geologists, even before the time of Brocchi, had justly inferred that119 the Apennines were elevated several thousand feet above the level of the Mediterranean before the deposition of the modern Subapennine beds which flank them on either side. What now constitutes the central calcareous chain of the Apennines must for a long time have been a narrow ridgy peninsula, branching off, at its northern extremity, from the Alps near Savona. This peninsula has since been raised from one to two thousand feet, by which movement the ancient shores, and, for a certain extent, the bed of the contiguous sea, have been laid dry, both on the side of the Mediterranean and the Adriatic.

That the existing lands didn't all rise up at once to their current position is shown by clear evidence. Several Italian geologists, even before Brocchi’s time, rightly concluded that119 the Apennines were lifted several thousand feet above the Mediterranean level before the modern Subapennine layers were deposited on either side of them. What is now the central limestone chain of the Apennines must have been a long, narrow peninsula, extending from the Alps near Savona at its northern end. This peninsula has since been raised by one to two thousand feet, causing ancient shores and a portion of the nearby sea floor to be exposed, affecting both the Mediterranean and the Adriatic sides.

Fig. 7.Mediterranean and the Adriatic.

The nature of these vicissitudes will be explained by the accompanying diagram, which represents a transverse section across the Italian peninsula. The inclined strata A are the disturbed formations of the Apennines, into which the ancient igneous rocks a are supposed to have intruded themselves. At a lower level on each flank of the chain are the more recent shelly beds b b, which often contain rounded pebbles derived from the waste of contiguous parts of the older Apennine limestone. These, it will be seen, are horizontal, and lie in what is termed "unconformable stratification" on the more ancient series. They now constitute a line of hills of moderate elevation between the sea and the Apennines, but never penetrate to the higher and more ancient valleys of that chain.

The nature of these changes will be explained by the accompanying diagram, which shows a cross section of the Italian peninsula. The tilted layers A are the disturbed formations of the Apennines, where the ancient volcanic rocks a are believed to have intruded. At a lower level on each side of the range are the more recent shelly layers b b, which often contain rounded pebbles from the erosion of nearby older Apennine limestone. These are horizontal and lie in what is called "unconformable stratification" on top of the older layers. They now form a line of moderately elevated hills between the sea and the Apennines, but they do not extend into the higher and older valleys of that range.

The same phenomena are exhibited in the Alps on a much grander scale; those mountains being composed in some even of their higher regions of the newer secondary and oldest tertiary formations, while they are encircled by a great zone of more modern tertiary rocks both on their southern flank towards the plains of the Po, and on the side of Switzerland and Austria, and at their eastern termination towards Styria and Hungary.198 This newer tertiary zone marks the position of former seas or gulfs, like the Adriatic, wherein masses of strata accumulated, some single groups of which are not inferior in thickness to the most voluminous of our secondary formations in England. Some even of these newer groups have been raised to the height of three or four thousand feet, and in proportion to their antiquity, they generally rise to greater heights, the older of them forming interior zones nearest to the central ridges of the Alps. We have already ascertained that the Alps gained accessions to their height and width at several successive peri120ods, and that the last series of improvements occurred when the seas were inhabited by many existing species of animals.

The same phenomena are seen in the Alps on a much larger scale; these mountains are made up, in some of their higher areas, of newer secondary and oldest tertiary formations, while they are surrounded by a significant zone of more modern tertiary rocks on their southern side towards the plains of the Po, and on the sides of Switzerland and Austria, and at their eastern end towards Styria and Hungary.198 This newer tertiary zone indicates where former seas or gulfs, like the Adriatic, once existed, where layers of strata formed, some of which are as thick as the largest of our secondary formations in England. Some of these newer layers have even been raised to heights of three or four thousand feet, and generally, the older they are, the greater their heights, with the oldest forming inner zones closest to the central ridges of the Alps. We’ve already established that the Alps gained height and width during several successive periods, with the last series of changes occurring when the seas were home to many existing species of animals.

We may imagine some future series of convulsions once more to heave up this stupendous chain, together with the adjoining bed of the sea, so that the mountains of Europe may rival the Andes in elevation; in which case the deltas of the Po, Adige, and Brenta, now encroaching upon the Adriatic, might be uplifted so as to form another exterior belt of considerable height around the southeastern flank of the Alps.

We might picture a future series of tremors that could lift this massive range back up, along with the nearby ocean floor, so that the mountains of Europe could rival the Andes in height. In that scenario, the deltas of the Po, Adige, and Brenta, which are currently extending into the Adriatic, could be raised to create another significant outer layer around the southeastern side of the Alps.

The Pyrenees, also, have acquired their present altitude, which in Mont Perdu exceeds eleven thousand feet, since the deposition of the nummulitic or Eocene division of the tertiary series. Some of the tertiary strata at the base of the chain are raised to the height of only a few hundred feet above the sea, and retain a horizontal position, without partaking in general in the disturbance to which the older series has been subjected; so that the great barrier between France and Spain was almost entirely upheaved in the interval between the deposition of certain groups of tertiary strata.

The Pyrenees have reached their current height, which at Mont Perdu surpasses eleven thousand feet, since the laying down of the nummulitic or Eocene era of the tertiary period. Some tertiary layers at the base of the range rise only a few hundred feet above sea level and remain horizontal, without being affected by the disturbances that impacted the older layers. This means that the large divide between France and Spain was mostly formed during the time between the deposition of certain groups of tertiary layers.

The remarkable break between the most modern of the known secondary rocks and the oldest tertiary, may be apparent only, and ascribable to the present deficiency of our information. Already the marles and green sand of Heers near Tongres, in Belgium, observed by M. Dumont, and the "pisolitic limestone" of the neighborhood of Paris, both intermediate in age between the Maestricht chalk and the lower Eocene strata, begin to afford us signs of a passage from one state of things to another. Nevertheless, it is far from impossible that the interval between the chalk and tertiary formations constituted an era in the earth's history, when the transition from one class of organic beings to another was, comparatively speaking, rapid. For if the doctrines above explained in regard to vicissitudes of temperature are sound, it will follow that changes of equal magnitude in the geographical features of the globe may at different periods produce very unequal effects on climate; and, so far as the existence of certain animals and plants depends on climate, the duration of species would be shortened or protracted, according to the rate at which the change of temperature proceeded.

The significant gap between the most modern known secondary rocks and the oldest tertiary rocks may seem noticeable, but it could just be due to our current lack of information. The marls and greensand of Heers near Tongres, Belgium, noted by M. Dumont, and the "pisolitic limestone" near Paris, both of which are intermediate in age between the Maestricht chalk and the lower Eocene strata, are starting to show us signs of a transition from one state to another. However, it's entirely possible that the time between the chalk and tertiary formations represented a period in Earth's history when the shift from one group of living things to another was relatively quick. If the theories mentioned about temperature fluctuations are accurate, it suggests that major changes in the Earth's geography could, at different times, lead to very different impacts on climate; and since the existence of certain animals and plants relies on climate, the lifespan of species could be either shortened or extended, depending on the speed of temperature change.

For even if we assume that the intensity of the subterranean disturbing forces is uniform and capable of producing nearly equal amounts of alteration on the surface of the planet, during equal periods of time, still the rate of alteration in climate would be by no means uniform. Let us imagine the quantity of land between the equator and the tropic in one hemisphere to be to that in the other as thirteen to one, which, as before stated, represents the unequal proportion of the extra-tropical lands in the two hemispheres at present. (See figs. 3 and 4, p. 110.) Then let the first geographical change consist in the shifting of this preponderance of land from one side of the line to the other; from the southern hemisphere, for example, to the northern. Now this need not affect the general temperature of the earth. But if, at another epoch, we suppose 121 a continuance of the same agency to transfer an equal volume of land from the torrid zone to the temperate and arctic regions of the northern and southern hemispheres, or into one of them, there might be so great a refrigeration of the mean temperature in all latitudes, that scarcely any of the pre-existing races of animals would survive; and, unless it pleased the Author of Nature that the planet should be uninhabited, new species, and probably of widely different forms, would then be substituted in the room of the extinct. We ought not, therefore, to infer that equal periods of time are always attended by an equal amount of change in organic life, since a great fluctuation in the mean temperature of the earth, the most influential cause which can be conceived in exterminating whole races of animals and plants, must, in different epochs, require unequal portions of time for its completion.

For even if we assume that the intensity of the underground disturbing forces is consistent and capable of causing nearly equal changes on the surface of the planet over the same amount of time, the rate at which the climate changes wouldn’t be uniform at all. Let’s imagine that the amount of land between the equator and the tropic in one hemisphere is to that in the other as thirteen to one, which, as mentioned before, represents the unequal distribution of extra-tropical lands in the two hemispheres currently. (See figs. 3 and 4, p. 110.) Now, let’s say the first geographical change involves moving this disproportion of land from one side of the line to the other; for instance, from the southern hemisphere to the northern. This shift doesn’t necessarily have to impact the overall temperature of the Earth. However, if, at another time, we assume the same process moves an equal amount of land from the hot zone to the temperate and arctic areas of both hemispheres, or just one of them, it could lead to such a significant drop in the average temperature in all latitudes that hardly any of the existing animal species would survive; and unless it is meant by the Author of Nature that the planet remains uninhabited, new species, likely of very different forms, would then replace the extinct ones. Therefore, we shouldn’t conclude that equal periods of time always bring about an equal amount of change in organic life, since a major fluctuation in the Earth’s average temperature, the most significant factor that could lead to the extinction of entire species of animals and plants, would require different lengths of time for its effects to fully develop across various epochs.

Dish I. Map showing the extent of surface in Europe which has at one period or another been covered by the sea since the commencement of the deposition of the older or Eocene Tertiary strata.
Map showing the extent of surface in Europe.

This map will enable the reader to perceive at a glance the great extent of change in the physical geography of Europe, which can be proved to have taken place since some of the older tertiary strata began to be deposited. The proofs of submergence, during some part or other of this period, in all the districts distinguished by ruled lines, are of a most unequivocal character; for the area thus described is now covered by deposits containing the fossil remains of animals which could only have lived in salt water. The most ancient part of the period referred to cannot be deemed very remote, considered geologically; because the deposits of the Paris and London basins, and many other districts belonging to the older tertiary epoch, are newer than the greater part of the sedimentary rocks (those commonly called secondary and primary fossiliferous or paleozoic) of which the crust of the globe is composed. The species, moreover, of marine testacea, of which the remains are found in these older tertiary formations, are not entirely distinct from such as now live. Yet, notwithstanding the comparatively recent epoch to which this retrospect is carried, the variations in the distribution of land and sea depicted on the map form only a part of those which must have taken place during the period under consideration. Some approximation has merely been made to an estimate of the amount of sea converted into land in parts of Europe best known to geologists; but we cannot determine how much land has become sea during the same period; and there may have been repeated interchanges of land and water in the same places, changes of which no account is taken in the map, and respecting the amount of which little accurate information can ever be obtained.

This map allows the reader to quickly see the significant changes in the physical geography of Europe that have occurred since the older tertiary layers began to form. The evidence of submergence during various times in all the areas marked with ruled lines is quite clear. This region is now covered by deposits that contain fossil remains of animals that could only have lived in saltwater. The earliest part of this period isn't considered very far back in geological terms because the deposits in the Paris and London basins, along with many other areas from the older tertiary period, are more recent than most of the sedimentary rocks (often referred to as secondary and primary fossiliferous or paleozoic) that make up the Earth's crust. Moreover, the species of marine shells found in these older tertiary formations are not entirely different from those living today. Yet, despite the relatively recent time frame of this overview, the changes in the distribution of land and sea shown on the map represent only a portion of what must have occurred during this time period. An estimate of the amount of sea converted into land has only been approximated in the parts of Europe best known to geologists; however, we cannot determine how much land has turned into sea during the same period. Moreover, there may have been repeated exchanges of land and water in the same locations, changes that are not reflected on the map, and regarding which little precise information can ever be gathered.

I have extended the sea in some instances beyond the limits of the land now covered by tertiary formations, and marine drift, because other geological data have been obtained for inferring the submergence of these 122 tracts after the deposition of the Eocene strata had begun. Thus, for example, there are good reasons for concluding that part of the chalk of England (the North and South Downs, for example, together with the intervening secondary tracts) continued beneath the sea until the oldest tertiary beds had begun to accumulate.

I have expanded the sea in some cases beyond the boundaries of the land currently covered by tertiary formations and marine drift because other geological evidence suggests these areas were submerged after the deposition of the Eocene layers had begun. For instance, there are solid reasons to believe that part of the chalk in England (like the North and South Downs, along with the gaps between them) remained under the sea until the earliest tertiary layers started to form. 122

A strait of the sea separating England and Wales has also been introduced, on the evidence afforded by shells of existing species found in a deposit of gravel, sand, loam, and clay, called the northern drift, by Sir R. Murchison.199 And Mr. Trimmer has discovered similar recent marine shells on the northern coast of North Wales, and on Moel Tryfane, near the Menai Straits, at the height of 1392 feet above the level of the sea!

A sea strait that separates England and Wales has also been identified based on the findings of shells from current species discovered in a layer of gravel, sand, loam, and clay known as the northern drift, by Sir R. Murchison.199 Additionally, Mr. Trimmer has found similar recent marine shells along the northern coast of North Wales, and on Moel Tryfane, which is at an elevation of 1392 feet above sea level!

Some raised sea-beaches, and drift containing marine shells, which I examined in 1843, between Limerick and Dublin, and which have been traced over other parts of Ireland by different geologists, have required an extension of the dark lines so as to divide that island into several. In improving this part of my map I have been especially indebted to the assistance of Mr. Oldham, who in 1843 announced to the British Association at Cork the fact that at the period when the drift or glacial beds were deposited, Ireland must have formed an archipelago such as is here depicted. A considerable part of Scotland might also have been represented in a similar manner as under water when the drift originated.

Some raised beaches and drift deposits containing marine shells that I looked at in 1843, between Limerick and Dublin, and which have been found in other parts of Ireland by various geologists, have necessitated extending the dark lines to divide the island into several sections. In improving this part of my map, I have been particularly grateful for the help of Mr. Oldham, who in 1843 reported to the British Association in Cork that during the time when the drift or glacial beds were formed, Ireland must have existed as an archipelago, as depicted here. A significant portion of Scotland may have also been represented similarly as underwater when the drift was formed.

A portion of Brittany is divided into islands, because it is known to be covered with patches of marine tertiary strata chiefly miocene. When I examined these in 1830 and 1843, I convinced myself that the sea must have covered much larger areas than are now occupied by these small and detached deposits. The former connection of the White Sea and the Gulf of Finland is proved by the fact that a multitude of huge erratic blocks extend over the intervening space, and a large portion of Norway, Sweden, and Denmark, as well as Germany and Russia, are represented as sea, on the same evidence, strengthened by the actual occurrence of fossil sea-shells, of recent species, in the drift of various portions of those countries. The submergence of considerable areas under large bodies of fresh water, during the tertiary period, of which there are many striking geological proofs in Auvergne, and elsewhere, has not been expressed by ruled lines. They bear testimony to the former existence of neighboring lands, and a certain elevation of the areas where they occur above the level of the ocean; they are therefore left blank, together with all the space that cannot be demonstrated to have been part of the sea at some time or other, since the commencement of the Eocene epoch.

A part of Brittany is made up of islands because it's known to be covered with patches of marine tertiary layers, mainly from the Miocene period. When I looked into these in 1830 and 1843, I realized that the sea must have covered much larger areas than what's currently taken up by these small and isolated deposits. The former connection between the White Sea and the Gulf of Finland is shown by the fact that many large erratic blocks stretch across the gap, and a significant portion of Norway, Sweden, Denmark, as well as Germany and Russia, are shown as sea based on the same evidence, which is backed up by the presence of fossil sea shells from recent species found in the drift of various parts of those countries. The flooding of large areas under vast bodies of fresh water during the tertiary period, which has several striking geological proofs in Auvergne and other places, hasn't been marked with ruled lines. They testify to the past existence of nearby lands, and indicate that the areas where they are found are elevated above sea level; that's why they are left blank, along with all the space that can't be shown to have been part of the sea at any time since the start of the Eocene epoch.

In compiling this map, which has been entirely recast since the first edition, I have availed myself of the latest geological maps of the British isles, and north of Europe; also of those published by the government surveyors of France, MM. de Beaumont and Dufresnoy; the map of 123 Germany and part of Europe, by Von Dechen, and that of Italy by M. Tchihatchoff (Berlin, 1842). Lastly, Sir R. Murchison's important map of Russia, and the adjoining countries, has enabled me to mark out not only a considerable area, previously little known, in which tertiary formations occur; but also a still wider expanse, over which the northern drift, and erratic blocks with occasional marine shells, are traceable. The southern limits of these glacial deposits in Russia and Germany indicate the boundary, so far as we can now determine it, of the northern ocean, at a period immediately antecedent to that of the human race.

In putting together this map, which has been completely revised since the first edition, I’ve made use of the most recent geological maps of the British Isles and Northern Europe; as well as those published by the French government surveyors, MM. de Beaumont and Dufresnoy; the map of 123 Germany and parts of Europe by Von Dechen, and that of Italy by M. Tchihatchoff (Berlin, 1842). Lastly, Sir R. Murchison's significant map of Russia and the surrounding countries has allowed me to outline not only a large area that was previously little known, containing tertiary formations, but also a broader region where the northern drift and erratic blocks with occasional marine shells can be found. The southern limits of these glacial deposits in Russia and Germany indicate the boundary, as far as we can currently determine, of the northern ocean at a time right before the existence of the human race.

I was anxious, even in the title of this map, to guard the reader against the supposition that it was intended to represent the state of the physical geography of part of Europe at any one point of time. The difficulty, or rather the impossibility, of restoring the geography of the globe as it may have existed at any former period, especially a remote one, consists in this, that we can only point out where part of the sea has been turned into land, and are almost always unable to determine what land may have become sea. All maps, therefore, pretending to represent the geography of remote geological epochs must be ideal. The map under consideration is not a restoration of a former state of things, at any particular moment of time, but a synoptical view of a certain amount of one kind of change (the conversion of sea into land) known to have been brought about within a given period.

I was concerned, even in the title of this map, to caution the reader against thinking that it aimed to show the physical geography of part of Europe at any specific moment in time. The challenge, or rather the impossibility, of accurately depicting the globe's geography as it may have existed in the past, especially in very distant times, lies in the fact that we can only indicate where some sea has been turned into land, and we are usually unable to determine what land may have become sea. Therefore, all maps that claim to represent the geography of ancient geological periods must be considered ideal. The map in question is not a reconstruction of a previous state of affairs at any specific point in time, but rather a summary view of a certain type of change (the transformation of sea into land) that is known to have occurred within a particular timeframe.

It may be proper to remark that the vertical movements to which the land is subject in certain regions, occasion alternately the subsidence and the uprising of the surface; and that, by such oscillations at successive periods, a great area may have been entirely covered with marine deposits, although the whole may never have been beneath the waters at one time; nay, even though the relative proportion of land and sea may have continued unaltered throughout the whole period. I believe, however, that since the commencement of the tertiary period, the dry land in the northern hemisphere has been continually on the increase, both because it is now greatly in excess beyond the average proportion which land generally bears to water on the globe, and because a comparison of the secondary and tertiary strata affords indications, as I have already shown, of a passage from the condition of an ocean interspersed with islands to that of a large continent.

It’s worth noting that in certain areas, the vertical movements of the land cause periodic sinking and rising of the surface. These oscillations over time can lead to large areas being completely covered in marine deposits, even if they weren’t all underwater at the same time. In fact, the balance of land and sea may have remained unchanged throughout this entire time. However, I believe that since the start of the tertiary period, dry land in the northern hemisphere has been steadily increasing. This is evident because the amount of land now significantly exceeds the average ratio of land to water on the planet, and a comparison of the secondary and tertiary layers suggests a shift from an ocean dotted with islands to the formation of a large continent.

But supposing it were possible to represent all the vicissitudes in the distribution of land and sea that have occurred during the tertiary period, and to exhibit not only the actual existence of land where there was once sea, but also the extent of surface now submerged which may once have been land, the map would still fail to express all the important revolutions in physical geography which have taken place within the epoch under consideration. For the oscillations of level, as was before stated, have not merely been such as to lift up the land from below the water, but in some cases to occasion a rise of many thousand feet above the sea. Thus the Alps have acquired an additional altitude of 4000, and even in some places 10,000 feet; and the Apennines owe a considerable 124 part of their present height to subterranean convulsions which have happened within the tertiary epoch.

But let's say it’s possible to show all the changes in land and sea distribution that have happened during the tertiary period, and to display not just where land exists now that used to be sea, but also the areas currently underwater that may have once been land; the map would still miss showing all the key changes in physical geography that took place during this time. As previously mentioned, the shifts in level have not only lifted land from under the water but, in some cases, raised it by thousands of feet above the sea. For instance, the Alps have gained an extra elevation of 4,000, and in some spots, up to 10,000 feet; and the Apennines owe a significant part of their current height to underground upheavals that occurred during the tertiary epoch.

On the other hand, some mountain chains may have been lowered during the same series of ages, in an equal degree, and shoals may have been converted into deep abysses.200 Since this map was recast in 1847, geologists have very generally come to the conclusion that the nummulitic limestone, together with the overlying fucoidal grit and shale, called "Flysch," in the Alps, belongs to the older tertiary or Eocene group. As these nummulitic rocks enter into the structure of some of the most lofty and disturbed parts of the Alps, Apennines, Carpathians, Pyrenees, and other mountain chains, and form many of the elevated lands of Africa and Asia, their position almost implies the ubiquity of the post-Eocene ocean, not, indeed, by the simultaneous, but by the successive, occupancy of the whole ground by its waters.201

On the other hand, some mountain ranges may have been lowered over the same period of time, to a similar extent, and shallow areas might have become deep abysses.200 Since this map was revised in 1847, geologists have largely concluded that the nummulitic limestone, along with the overlying fucoidal grit and shale known as "Flysch," in the Alps, is part of the older tertiary or Eocene group. As these nummulitic rocks are found in the structure of some of the highest and most disturbed regions of the Alps, Apennines, Carpathians, Pyrenees, and other mountain ranges, and contribute to many elevated areas in Africa and Asia, their position nearly suggests that the post-Eocene ocean was widespread, not by being occupied at the same time, but by its waters successively covering the entire area.201

Concluding remarks on changes in physical geography.—The foregoing observations, it may be said, are confined chiefly to Europe, and therefore merely establish the increase of dry land in a space which constitutes but a small portion of the northern hemisphere; but it was stated in the preceding chapter, that the great Lowland of Siberia, lying chiefly between the latitudes 55° and 75° N. (an area nearly equal to all Europe), is covered for the most part by marine strata, which, from the account given by Pallas, and more recently by Sir R. Murchison, belongs to a period when all or nearly all the shells were of a species still living in the north. The emergence, therefore, of this area from the deep is, comparatively speaking, a very modern event, and must, as before remarked, have caused a great increase of cold throughout the globe.

Concluding remarks on changes in physical geography.—The observations mentioned above are mainly focused on Europe, which only accounts for a small part of the northern hemisphere. However, as noted in the previous chapter, the vast Lowland of Siberia, located mainly between latitudes 55° and 75° N. (an area nearly the size of all of Europe), is mostly covered by marine layers. According to Pallas and more recently Sir R. Murchison, this area dates back to a time when almost all the shells found there belong to species still alive in the north today. Thus, the rise of this land from the sea is a relatively recent occurrence and, as previously mentioned, must have significantly increased cold temperatures around the world.

Upon a review, then, of all the facts above enumerated, respecting the ancient geography of the globe as attested by geological monuments, there appear good grounds for inferring that changes of climate coincided with remarkable revolutions in the former position of sea and land. A wide expanse of ocean, interspersed with islands, seems to have pervaded the northern hemisphere at the periods when the Silurian and carboniferous rocks were formed, and a warm and very uniform temperature then prevailed. Subsequent modifications in climate accompanied the deposition of the secondary formations, when repeated changes were effected in the physical geography of our northern latitudes. Lastly, the refrigeration became most decided, and the climate most nearly assimilated to that now enjoyed, when the lands in Europe and northern Asia had attained their full extension, and the mountain chains their actual height.

Upon reviewing all the facts mentioned above about the ancient geography of the Earth as indicated by geological evidence, there seems to be solid reasons to suggest that climate changes coincided with significant shifts in the arrangement of land and sea. A vast ocean, dotted with islands, appears to have covered the northern hemisphere during the times when the Silurian and carboniferous rocks were formed, and a warm, evenly distributed temperature was prevalent. Later changes in climate occurred alongside the formation of secondary deposits, during which multiple transformations happened in the physical geography of our northern regions. Finally, significant cooling took place, making the climate resemble what we experience today, as the land in Europe and northern Asia reached its full extent and the mountain ranges achieved their current height.

Soon after the first publication of this theory of climate, an objection was made by an anonymous German critic in 1833 that there are no geological proofs of the prevalence at any former period of a temperature 125lower than that now enjoyed; whereas, if the causes above assigned were the true ones, it might reasonably have been expected that fossil remains would sometimes indicate colder as well as hotter climates than those now established.202 In answer to this objection, I may suggest, that our present climates are probably far more distant from the extreme of possible heat than from its opposite extreme of cold. A glance at the map (fig. 6, p. 111) will show that all the existing lands might be placed between the 30th parallels of latitude on each side of the equator, and that even then they would by no means fill that space. In no other position would they give rise to so high a temperature. But the present geographical condition of the earth is so far removed from such a state of things, that the land lying between the poles and the parallels of 30, is in great excess; so much so that, instead of being to the sea in the proportion of 1 to 3, which is as near as possible the average general ratio throughout the globe, it is 9 to 23.203 Hence it ought not to surprise us if, in our geological retrospect, embracing perhaps a small part only of a complete cycle of change in the terrestrial climates, we should happen to discover everywhere the signs of a higher temperature. The strata hitherto examined may have originated when the quantity of equatorial land was always decreasing and the land in regions nearer the poles augmenting in height and area, until at length it attained its present excess in high latitudes. There is nothing improbable in supposing that the geographical revolutions of which we have hitherto obtained proofs had this general tendency; and in that case the refrigeration must have been constant, although, for reasons before explained, the rate of cooling may not have been uniform.

Soon after the first publication of this climate theory, an anonymous German critic raised an objection in 1833, claiming that there is no geological evidence of any past period having a temperature 125lower than what we experience today. If the causes mentioned earlier were accurate, we could reasonably expect fossil remains to show evidence of both colder and hotter climates compared to what we currently have.202 In response to this objection, I would suggest that our current climates are likely much farther from the extreme of possible heat than from the extreme of cold. A quick look at the map (fig. 6, p. 111) shows that all existing land could fit between the 30th parallels of latitude north and south of the equator, and even then, it wouldn’t cover the whole area. In no other position would it create such high temperatures. However, the current geographical layout of the earth is so different from that situation that the land between the poles and the 30th parallels is in considerable excess. Instead of being in a ratio of about 1 to 3 with the sea, which is the average ratio globally, it is now 9 to 23.203 Therefore, it shouldn't be surprising if, while looking back at geological history, which may only reflect a small part of a complete cycle of climate changes, we find evidence of consistently higher temperatures. The layers we've examined so far could have formed when the amount of equatorial land was continuously decreasing, while the land closer to the poles was increasing in height and area until it reached its current excess in high latitudes. There’s nothing unlikely about assuming that the geographical changes we've seen so far had this overall trend; and in that case, cooling must have been ongoing, even if the rate of cooling wasn't uniform for the reasons explained earlier.

It may, however, be as well to recall the reader's attention to what was before said of the indication brought to light of late years, of a considerable oscillation of temperature, in the period immediately preceding the human era. We have seen that on examining some of the most northern deposits, those commonly called the northern drift in Scotland, Ireland, and Canada, in which nearly all, in some cases, perhaps all, the fossil shells are of recent species, we discover the signs of a climate colder than that now prevailing in corresponding latitudes on both sides the Atlantic. It appears that an arctic fauna specifically resembling that of the present seas, extended farther to the south than now. This opinion is derived partly from the known habitations of the corresponding living species, and partly from the abundance of certain genera of shells 126 and the absence of others.204 The date of the refrigeration thus inferred appears to coincide very nearly with the era of the dispersion of erratic blocks over Europe and North America, a phenomenon which will be ascribed in the sequel (ch. 16) to the cold then prevailing in the northern hemisphere. The force, moreover, of the German critic's objection has been since in a great measure destroyed, by the larger and more profound knowledge acquired in the last few years of the ancient carboniferous flora, which has led the ablest botanists to adopt the opinion, that the climate of the coal period was remarkable for its warmth, moisture, equability, and freedom from cold, rather than the intensity of its tropical heat. We are therefore no longer entitled to assume that there has been a constant and gradual decline in the absolute amount of heat formerly contained in the atmosphere and waters of the ocean, such as it was conjectured might have emanated from the incandescent central nucleus of a new and nearly fluid planet, before the interior had lost, by radiation into surrounding space, a great part of its original high temperature.

It might be helpful to remind readers about what was previously mentioned regarding the recent discovery of a significant temperature fluctuation during the time right before human history began. We've seen that when examining some of the northern deposits, commonly known as the northern drift in Scotland, Ireland, and Canada—where nearly all, and in some cases possibly all, of the fossil shells belong to recent species—we notice signs of a climate that was colder than what we find today in similar latitudes on both sides of the Atlantic. It seems that an arctic fauna, resembling that of today's seas, extended much further south than it does now. This viewpoint comes from the established habitats of corresponding living species and from the prevalence of certain shell genera and the absence of others. The date of the inferred cooling seems to closely align with the time when erratic blocks were dispersed across Europe and North America, a phenomenon that will be attributed in later sections (ch. 16) to the cold conditions that existed in the northern hemisphere at that time. Furthermore, the strength of the German critic's objection has significantly diminished, thanks to the deeper knowledge gained in recent years about ancient carboniferous flora, which has led leading botanists to conclude that the climate during the coal period was noted for its warmth, moisture, stability, and lack of cold, rather than the intensity of its tropical heat. Therefore, we can no longer assume that there has been a steady and gradual decline in the overall heat previously present in the atmosphere and ocean waters, which was speculated to have originated from the glowing central core of a new and nearly fluid planet before its interior lost a significant amount of its initial high temperature through radiation into space.

Astronomical causes of fluctuations in climate.—Sir John Herschel has lately inquired, whether there are any astronomical causes which may offer a possible explanation of the difference between the actual climate of the earth's surface, and those which formerly appear to have prevailed. He has entered upon this subject, he says, "impressed with the magnificence of that view of geological revolutions, which regards them rather as regular and necessary effects of great and general causes, than as resulting from a series of convulsions and catastrophes, regulated by no laws, and reducible to no fixed principles." Geometers, he adds, have demonstrated the absolute invariability of the mean distance of the earth from the sun; whence it would at first seem to follow, that the mean annual supply of light and heat derived from that luminary would be alike invariable: but a closer consideration of the subject will show, that this would not be a legitimate conclusion; but that on the contrary, the mean amount of solar radiation is dependent on the eccentricity of the earth's orbit, and therefore liable to variation.205

Astronomical causes of fluctuations in climate.—Sir John Herschel recently asked whether there are any astronomical factors that could help explain the differences between the current climate of the Earth's surface and those that seem to have existed in the past. He approached this topic, he says, "impressed by the grandeur of the perspective on geological changes, which views them as regular and necessary outcomes of significant and universal causes, rather than as the result of a series of upheavals and disasters, governed by no rules and not reducible to any fixed principles." He adds that geometers have proven the absolute consistency of the average distance of the Earth from the sun; therefore, it would initially seem that the average annual amount of light and heat from that star would also remain constant. However, a closer examination will reveal that this is not a valid conclusion; rather, the mean level of solar radiation depends on the eccentricity of Earth's orbit, and is thus subject to variation.205

Now the eccentricity of the orbit, he continues, is actually diminishing, and has been so for ages beyond the records of history. In consequence, the ellipse is in a state of approach to a circle, and the annual average of solar heat radiated to the earth is actually on the decrease. So far this is in accordance with geological evidence, which indicates a general refrigeration of climate; but the question remains, whether the amount of diminution which the eccentricity may have ever undergone can be supposed sufficient to account for any sensible refrigeration. The calculations 127 necessary to determine this point, though practicable, have never yet been made, and would be extremely laborious; for they must embrace all the perturbations which the most influential planets, Venus, Mars, Jupiter, and Saturn, would cause in the earth's orbit, and in each other's movements round the sun.

Now, the eccentricity of the orbit, he goes on, is actually decreasing and has been for a long time, far beyond what history records. As a result, the ellipse is getting closer to a circle, and the average solar heat radiated to the earth is actually on the decline. So far, this aligns with geological evidence, which shows a general cooling of the climate; but the question remains whether the degree of reduction that the eccentricity has ever experienced can be considered enough to explain any noticeable cooling. The calculations 127 needed to determine this, while possible, have never been done, and would be extremely tedious; because they must take into account all the disturbances caused by the most influential planets, Venus, Mars, Jupiter, and Saturn, in the earth's orbit and in their movements around the sun.

The problem is also very complicated, inasmuch as it depends not merely on the ellipticity of the earth's orbit, but on the assumed temperature of the celestial spaces beyond the earth's atmosphere; a matter still open to discussion, and on which M. Fourier and Sir J. Herschel have arrived at very different opinions. But if, says Herschel, we suppose an extreme case, as if the earth's orbit should ever become as eccentric as that of the planet Juno or Pallas, a great change of climate might be conceived to result, the winter and summer temperatures being sometimes mitigated, and at others exaggerated, in the same latitudes.

The issue is quite complex because it doesn’t just rely on the shape of the Earth's orbit, but also on the estimated temperature of the space beyond the Earth's atmosphere; this is still up for debate, with M. Fourier and Sir J. Herschel holding very different views on it. However, if we take an extreme example, as Herschel suggests, where the Earth’s orbit became as elongated as that of the planet Juno or Pallas, we could imagine significant climate changes occurring, leading to varying winter and summer temperatures that could sometimes be milder or, at other times, more intense in the same regions.

It is much to be desired that the calculations alluded to were executed, as even if they should demonstrate, as M. Arago thinks highly probable,206 that the mean amount of solar radiation can never be materially affected by irregularities in the earth's motion, it would still be satisfactory to ascertain the point. Such inquiries, however, can never supersede the necessity of investigating the consequences of the varying position of continents, shifted as we know them to have been during successive epochs, from one part of the globe to the other.

It would be really valuable if the calculations mentioned were done, because even if they show, as M. Arago believes is very likely,206 that the average amount of solar radiation isn't significantly impacted by changes in the earth's movement, it would still be good to know for sure. However, such studies can never replace the need to examine the effects of the changing positions of continents, which we've seen move from one part of the globe to another over different periods.

Another astronomical hypothesis respecting the possible cause of secular variations in climate, has been proposed by a distinguished mathematician and philosopher, M. Poisson. He begins by assuming, 1st, that the sun and our planetary system are not stationary, but carried onward by a common movement through space; 2dly, that every point in space receives heat as well as light from innumerable stars surrounding it on all sides, so that if a right line of indefinite length be produced in any direction from such a point, it must encounter a star either visible or invisible to us. 3dly, He then goes on to assume, that the different regions of space, which in the course of millions of years are traversed by our system, must be of very unequal temperature, inasmuch as some of them must receive a greater, others a less, quantity of radiant heat from the great stellary inclosure. If the earth, he continues, or any other large body, pass from a hotter to a colder region, it would not readily lose in the second all the heat which it has imbibed in the first region, but retain a temperature increasing downwards from the surface, as in the actual condition of our planet.207

Another theory about what might cause long-term climate changes has been suggested by a well-known mathematician and philosopher, M. Poisson. He starts by assuming, 1st, that the sun and our solar system aren’t stationary but are moving together through space; 2nd, that every point in space receives heat as well as light from countless stars surrounding it, so that if you extend a straight line of any length from that point, it will eventually hit a star, whether we can see it or not. 3rd, he goes on to assume that the different areas of space our system passes through over millions of years must have very different temperatures, since some of these areas must receive more radiant heat while others receive less from the vast star field. If the Earth, he adds, or any other large body moves from a hotter area to a colder one, it wouldn’t quickly lose all the heat it absorbed from the hotter area, but would maintain a temperature that increases as you go deeper beneath the surface, just like we see on our planet today.207

Now the opinion originally suggested by Sir W. Herschel, that our sun and its attendant planets were all moving onward through space, in the direction of the constellation Hercules, is very generally thought by eminent astronomers to be confirmed. But even if its reality be 128 no longer matter of doubt, conjectures as to its amount are still vague and uncertain; and great, indeed, must be the extent of the movement before this cause alone can work any material alteration in the terrestrial climates. Mr. Hopkins, when treating of this theory, remarked, that so far as we were acquainted with the position of the stars not very remote from the sun, they seem to be so distant from each other, that there are no points in space among them, where the intensity of radiating heat would be comparable to that which the earth derives from the sun, except at points very near to each star. Thus, in order that the earth should derive a degree of heat from stellar radiation comparable to that now derived from the sun, she must be in close proximity to some particular star, leaving the aggregate effect of radiation from the other stars nearly the same as at present. This approximation, however, to a single star could not take place consistently with the preservation of the motion of the earth about the sun, according to its present laws.

Now, the idea originally proposed by Sir W. Herschel that our sun and its planets are all moving through space toward the constellation Hercules is widely accepted by prominent astronomers. However, even if its existence is no longer in doubt, estimates of its scale are still unclear and uncertain. The movement must be considerable before this alone can significantly change Earth's climates. Mr. Hopkins, while discussing this theory, noted that based on our understanding of the positions of nearby stars, they seem so far apart that there are no areas in space among them where the heat radiated would match what Earth receives from the sun, except very close to each individual star. Therefore, for Earth to receive a comparable amount of heat from star radiation as it currently does from the sun, it would need to be in close proximity to a specific star, while the combined effect of radiation from other stars would remain roughly the same as it is now. However, this close proximity to a single star would not be compatible with the way Earth currently orbits the sun.

Suppose our sun should approach a star within the present distance of Neptune. That planet could no longer remain a member of the solar system, and the motions of the other planets would be disturbed in a degree which no one has ever contemplated as probable since the existence of the solar system. But such a star, supposing it to be no larger than the sun, and to emit the same quantity of heat, would not send to the earth much more than one-thousandth part of the heat which she derives from the sun, and would therefore produce only a very small change in terrestrial temperature.208

Suppose our sun moved close to a star at the current distance of Neptune. That planet would no longer be part of the solar system, and the orbits of the other planets would be disturbed in ways that no one has ever considered likely since the solar system came into existence. But if this star were no bigger than the sun and emitted the same amount of heat, it would only provide the Earth with about one-thousandth of the heat it gets from the sun, leading to just a very slight change in temperature on Earth.208

Variable splendor of stars.—There is still another astronomical suggestion respecting the possible causes of secular variations in the terrestrial climates which deserves notice. It has long been known that certain stars are liable to great and periodical fluctuations in splendor, and Sir J. Herschel has lately ascertained (Jan. 1840), that a large and brilliant star, called alpha Orionis, sustained, in the course of six weeks, a loss of nearly half its light. "This phenomenon," he remarks, "cannot fail to awaken attention, and revive those speculations which were first put forth by my father Sir W. Herschel, respecting the possibility of a change in the lustre of our sun itself. If there really be a community of nature between the sun and fixed stars, every proof that we obtain of the extensive prevalence of such periodical changes in those remote bodies, adds to the probability of finding something of the kind nearer home." Referring then to the possible bearing of such facts on ancient revolutions, in terrestrial climates, he says, that "it is a matter of observed fact, that many stars have undergone, in past ages, within the records of astronomical history, very extensive changes in apparent lustre, without a change of distance adequate to producing such an effect. If our sun were even intrinsically much brighter than at present, the mean temperature of the surface of our globe would, of course, be proportionally greater. I speak now not of periodical, but of secular 129 changes. But the argument is complicated with the consideration of the possibly imperfect transparency of the celestial spaces, and with the cause of that imperfect transparency, which may be due to material non-luminous particles diffused irregularly in patches analogous to nebulæ, but of greater extent—to cosmical clouds, in short—of whose existence we have, I think, some indication in the singular and apparently capricious phenomena of temporary stars, and perhaps in the recent extraordinary sudden increase and hardly less sudden diminution of η Argus."209

Variable splendor of stars.—There’s another astronomical idea regarding the potential causes of long-term changes in Earth’s climates that’s worth mentioning. It’s been known for a while that some stars experience significant and periodic changes in brightness, and Sir J. Herschel recently discovered (Jan. 1840) that a large and bright star, known as alpha Orionis, lost nearly half its light over a span of six weeks. "This phenomenon," he states, "is bound to grab attention and rekindle the theories first proposed by my father, Sir W. Herschel, about the possibility of a change in the brightness of our sun itself. If there truly is a connection between the sun and fixed stars, every piece of evidence we find showing these periodic changes in distant stars increases the likelihood of encountering something similar closer to home." He goes on to discuss how these facts might relate to ancient shifts in Earth's climates, noting that "it’s a documented fact that many stars have undergone significant changes in brightness throughout the records of astronomical history, without a corresponding change in distance that could explain such an effect. If our sun were even intrinsically much brighter than it is now, the average temperature of our planet would certainly be proportionally higher. I’m talking now about long-term, not periodic changes. However, this argument is complicated by the possibility of the celestial spaces being imperfectly transparent, and the cause of that imperfect transparency, which might be due to non-luminous particles scattered in patches akin to nebulae, but on a larger scale—essentially cosmical clouds—the existence of which we have some evidence for in the strange and seemingly random phenomena of temporary stars, as well as in the recent extraordinary and sudden increase followed by an equally rapid decrease of η Argus."209

More recently (1852) Schwabe has observed that the spots on the sun alternately increase and decrease in the course of every ten years, and Captain Sabine has pointed out that this variable obscuration coincides in time both as to its maximum and minimum with changes in all those terrestrial magnetic variations which are caused by the sun. Hence he infers that the period of alteration in the spots is a solar magnetic period. Assuming such to be the case, the variable light of some stars may indicate a similar phenomenon, or they may be stellar magnetic periods, differing only in the degree of obscuration and its duration. And as hitherto we have perceived no fluctuation in the heat received by the earth from the sun coincident with the solar magnetic period, so the fluctuations in the brilliancy of the stars may not perhaps be attended with any perceptible alteration in their power of radiating heat. But before we can speculate with advantage in this new and interesting field of inquiry, we require more facts and observations.

More recently (1852), Schwabe observed that the spots on the sun increase and decrease alternately every ten years. Captain Sabine has noted that this variable obscuration aligns in time, both at its peak and its lowest point, with changes in all those terrestrial magnetic variations caused by the sun. Therefore, he concludes that the period of change in the spots is a solar magnetic period. If that's the case, the variable brightness of some stars may indicate a similar phenomenon, or they could be stellar magnetic periods, differing only in the degree of obscuration and its duration. And since we haven't noticed any fluctuation in the heat received by the Earth from the sun that corresponds with the solar magnetic period, the changes in the brightness of stars may not be accompanied by any noticeable change in their ability to radiate heat. However, before we can effectively speculate in this new and fascinating area of study, we need more facts and observations.

Supposed gradual diminution of the earth's primitive heat.—The gradual diminution of the supposed primitive heat of the globe has been resorted to by many geologists as the principal cause of alterations of climate. The matter of our planet is imagined, in accordance with the conjectures of Leibnitz, to have been originally in an intensely heated state, and to have been parting ever since with portions of its heat, and at the same time contracting its dimensions. There are, undoubtedly, good grounds for inferring from recent observation and experiment, that the temperature of the earth increases as we descend from the surface to that slight depth to which man can penetrate: but there are no positive proofs of a secular decrease of internal heat accompanied by contraction. On the contrary, La Place has shown, by reference to astronomical observations made in the time of Hipparchus, that in the last two thousand years at least there has been no sensible contraction of the globe by cooling; for had this been the case, even to an extremely small amount, the day would have been shortened, whereas its length has certainly not diminished during that period by 1/300th of a second.

Supposed gradual decrease of the earth's original heat.—Many geologists have suggested that the gradual decrease of what is believed to be the earth's original heat is the main reason for changes in climate. According to theories by Leibnitz, it's thought that our planet was once in a very hot state and has been losing heat over time while also shrinking in size. There is strong evidence from recent observations and experiments to indicate that temperature increases as we go deeper from the surface to a depth that humans can reach. However, there is no solid evidence of a long-term decrease in internal heat accompanied by contraction. On the contrary, La Place has pointed out, based on astronomical observations from the time of Hipparchus, that over the last two thousand years, there has been no noticeable contraction of the globe due to cooling. If there had been even a tiny amount of contraction, the length of the day would have shortened, but it certainly hasn't decreased during that period by even 1/300th of a second.

Baron Fourier, after making a curious series of experiments on the cooling of incandescent bodies, considers it to be proved mathematically, that the actual distribution of heat in the earth's envelope is precisely 130 that which would have taken place if the globe had been formed in a medium of a very high temperature, and had afterwards been constantly cooled.210 He contends, that although no contraction can be demonstrated to have taken place within the historical period (the operation being slow and the time of observation limited), yet it is no less certain that heat is annually passing out by radiation from the interior of the globe into the planetary spaces. He even undertook to demonstrate that the quantity of heat thus transmitted into space in the course of every century, through every square metre of the earth's surface, would suffice to melt a column of ice having a square metre for its base, and being three metres (or 9 feet 10 inches) high.

Baron Fourier, after conducting a fascinating series of experiments on the cooling of glowing objects, believes he has mathematically proven that the actual distribution of heat in the Earth's atmosphere is exactly what would have occurred if the planet had formed in a very high-temperature environment and then had been gradually cooled down.130 He argues that, while no contraction can be shown to have occurred during recorded history (since the process is slow and our observation time is limited), it is still certain that heat is escaping annually by radiation from the Earth’s interior into space. He even tried to show that the amount of heat radiated into space every century, through every square meter of the Earth's surface, would be enough to melt a column of ice with a one-square-meter base and a height of three meters (or 9 feet 10 inches).

It is at the same time denied, that there is any assignable mode in which the heat thus lost by radiation can be again restored to the earth, and consequently the interior of our planet must, from the moment of its creation, have been subject to refrigeration, and is destined together with the sun and stars forever to grow colder. But I shall point out in the sequel (chapter 31) many objections to these views, and to the theory of the intense heat of the earth's central nucleus, and shall then inquire how far the observed augmentation of temperature, as we descend below the surface, may be referable to other causes unconnected with the supposed pristine fluidity of the entire globe.

It is also denied that there is any specific way for the heat lost through radiation to be returned to the Earth. As a result, the planet's interior must have been cooling since its creation and is destined to continue growing colder, along with the sun and stars, forever. However, I will point out many objections to these ideas and the theory regarding the intense heat of the Earth's core in the next section (chapter 31). I will also investigate how much of the temperature increase we observe as we go deeper below the surface can be attributed to other factors unrelated to the idea that the entire globe was once fluid.


CHAPTER IX.

THEORY OF THE PROGRESSIVE DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANIC LIFE AT SUCCESSIVE GEOLOGICAL PERIODS.

Theory of the progressive development of organic life—Evidence in its support inconclusive—Vertebrated animals, and plants of the most perfect organization, in strata of very high antiquity—Differences between the organic remains of successive formations—Comparative modern origin of the human race—The popular doctrine of successive development not established by the admission that man is of modern origin—Introduction of man, to what extent a change in the system.

Theory of the progressive development of organic life—The evidence supporting it is inconclusive—Vertebrate animals and highly organized plants found in very ancient layers—Differences between the organic remains of successive formations—The modern origins of the human race—The common belief in successive development isn’t backed up by the idea that humans have a modern origin—The introduction of humans, how significantly it alters the system.

Progressive development of organic life.—In the preceding chapters I have considered whether revolutions in the general climate of the globe afford any just ground of opposition to the doctrine that the former changes of the earth which are treated of in geology belong to one uninterrupted series of physical events governed by ordinary causes. Against this doctrine some popular arguments have been derived from the great vicissitudes of the organic creation in times past; I shall 131 therefore proceed to the discussion of such objections, which have been thus formally advanced by the late Sir Humphrey Davy. "It is impossible," he affirms, "to defend the proposition, that the present order of things is the ancient and constant order of nature, only modified by existing laws: in those strata which are deepest, and which must, consequently, be supposed to be the earliest deposited, forms even of vegetable life are rare; shells and vegetable remains are found in the next order; the bones of fishes and oviparous reptiles exist in the following class; the remains of birds, with those of the same genera mentioned before, in the next order; those of quadrupeds of extinct species in a still more recent class; and it is only in the loose and slightly consolidated strata of gravel and sand, and which are usually called diluvian formations, that the remains of animals such as now people the globe are found, with others belonging to extinct species. But, in none of these formations, whether called secondary, tertiary, or diluvial, have the remains of man, or any of his works, been discovered; and whoever dwells upon this subject must be convinced, that the present order of things, and the comparatively recent existence of man as the master of the globe, is as certain as the destruction of a former and a different order, and the extinction of a number of living forms which have no types in being. In the oldest secondary strata there are no remains of such animals as now belong to the surface; and in the rocks, which may be regarded as more recently deposited, these remains occur but rarely, and with abundance of extinct species;—there seems, as it were, a gradual approach to the present system of things, and a succession of destructions and creations preparatory to the existence of man."211

Progressive development of organic life.—In the previous chapters, I examined whether changes in the Earth's climate provide any valid objections to the idea that the earlier shifts of the Earth discussed in geology are part of a continuous series of physical events caused by natural processes. Some popular arguments against this idea stem from the significant changes in organic life in the past. Therefore, I will address such objections, which have been formally presented by the late Sir Humphrey Davy. "It is impossible," he states, "to defend the idea that the current state of things is the ancient and consistent order of nature, only altered by existing laws: in the deepest strata, which must therefore be considered the earliest deposited, forms of plant life are rare; shells and plant remains are found in the next layer; the bones of fish and egg-laying reptiles occur in the following category; the remains of birds, along with those previously mentioned, appear in the next layer; the remains of extinct quadrupeds are found in a more recent class; and only in the loose and slightly consolidated layers of gravel and sand, often referred to as flood formations, are remains of animals that populate the modern world found, alongside those of extinct species. However, in none of these formations, whether they are classified as secondary, tertiary, or flood deposits, have remains of humans or any of their creations been discovered; and anyone who considers this issue must be convinced that the current state of affairs, and the relatively recent appearance of humans as the dominant species on Earth, is as definitive as the destruction of a former and different order and the extinction of numerous living forms that have no current counterparts. In the oldest secondary layers, there are no remains of the animals that currently inhabit the surface; and in the rocks that may be considered more recently deposited, these remains appear only rarely, alongside a majority of extinct species—there seems to be a gradual transition to the present system and a series of destructions and creations leading up to the existence of humans."211

In the above passages, the author deduces two important conclusions from geological data: first, that in the successive groups of strata, from the oldest to the most recent, there is a progressive development of organic life, from the simplest to the most complicated forms;—secondly, that man is of comparatively recent origin, and these conclusions he regards as inconsistent with the doctrine, "that the present order of things is the ancient and constant order of nature only modified by existing laws."

In the passages above, the author draws two key conclusions from geological data: first, that in the layers of rock, from the oldest to the newest, there is a steady development of living organisms, from the simplest to the most complex forms; secondly, that humans originated relatively recently, and he considers these conclusions to be at odds with the idea that "the present order of things is just a modified version of the ancient and constant order of nature."

With respect, then, to the first of these propositions, we may ask whether the theory of the progressive development of animal and vegetable life, and their successive advancement from a simple to a more perfect state, has any secure foundation in fact? No geologists who are in possession of all the data now established respecting fossil remains, will for a moment contend for the doctrine in all its detail, as laid down by the distinguished philosopher to whose opinions we have referred: but naturalists, who are not unacquainted with recent discoveries, continue to defend it in a modified form. They say that in the first period of the world (by which they mean the earliest of which we have yet brought to light any memorials), the vegetation was characterized by a predominance of cryptogamic plants, while the animals 132 which coexisted were almost entirely confined to zoophytes, testacea, and a few fish. Plants of a less simple structure, coniferæ and cycadeæ, flourished largely in the next epoch, when oviparous reptiles began also to abound. Lastly, the terrestrial flora became most diversified and most perfect when the highest orders of animals, the mammalia and birds, were called into existence.

Regarding the first of these propositions, we can ask whether the theory of the progressive development of animal and plant life, and their gradual advancement from a simple to a more advanced state, is based on solid facts. No geologists who have all the current data on fossil remains would fully support the detailed doctrine proposed by the distinguished philosopher we mentioned: however, naturalists, familiar with recent discoveries, still defend it in a revised way. They argue that in the earliest period of the world (referring to the earliest evidence we have uncovered), vegetation was marked by a dominance of non-flowering plants, while the animals that existed were mostly limited to simple organisms like corals, shells, and a few fish. In the next period, more complex plants, such as conifers and cycads, thrived alongside a rise in oviparous reptiles. Finally, the land flora became the most diverse and advanced when the highest groups of animals, the mammals and birds, came into being.

Now in the first place, it may be observed, that many naturalists are guilty of no small inconsistency in endeavoring to connect the phenomena of the earliest vegetation with a nascent condition of organic life, and at the same time to deduce from the numerical predominance of certain forms, the greater heat or uniformity of the ancient climate. The arguments in favor of the latter conclusion are without any force, unless we can assume that the rules followed by the Author of Nature in the creation and distribution of organic beings were the same formerly as now; and that, as certain families of animals and plants are now most abundant in, or exclusively confined to regions where there is a certain temperature, a certain degree of humidity, a certain intensity of light, and other conditions, so also analogous phenomena were exhibited at every former era.

Now, to begin with, it's clear that many naturalists are inconsistent when they try to link the early stages of vegetation with the initial development of organic life while also suggesting that the dominance of certain forms indicates a warmer or more uniform ancient climate. The arguments supporting the latter conclusion aren’t convincing unless we accept that the rules followed by Nature in creating and distributing living beings were the same in the past as they are today. Just as certain groups of animals and plants are currently most abundant in or limited to regions with specific temperatures, levels of humidity, light intensity, and other conditions, it’s also likely that similar patterns existed in previous eras.

If this postulate be denied, and the prevalence of particular families be declared to depend on a certain order of precedence in the introduction of different classes into the earth, and if it be maintained that the standard of organization was raised successively, we must then ascribe the numerical preponderance, in the earlier ages, of plants of simpler structure, not to the heat, or other climatal conditions, but to those different laws which regulate organic life in newly created worlds.

If this assumption is rejected, and it's stated that the dominance of certain families is based on a specific order of introduction of various classes into the world, and if it's argued that the level of organization increased over time, then we must attribute the numerical dominance of simpler plants in earlier times, not to the heat or other climatic factors, but to the different laws that govern organic life in newly formed worlds.

Before we can infer a warm and uniform temperature in high latitudes, from the presence of 250 species of ferns, some of them arborescent, accompanied by lycopadiacæ of large size, and araucariæ, we must be permitted to assume, that at all times, past, present, and future, a heated and moist atmosphere pervading the northern hemisphere has a tendency to produce in the vegetation a predominance of analogous forms.

Before we can conclude that high latitudes have a warm and consistent temperature based on the presence of 250 species of ferns, some of which are tree-like, along with large lycopods and araucarias, we have to assume that, at all times—past, present, and future—a warm and humid atmosphere in the northern hemisphere tends to create a dominance of similar types of vegetation.

It should moreover be borne in mind, when we are considering the question of development from a botanical point of view, that naturalists are by no means agreed as to the existence of an ascending scale of organization in the vegetable world corresponding to that which is very generally recognized in animals. "From the sponge to man," in the language of De Blainville, there may be a progressive chain of being, although often broken and imperfect; but if we seek to classify plants according to a linear arrangement, ascending gradually from the lichen to the lily or the rose, we encounter incomparably greater difficulties. Yet the doctrine of a more highly developed organization in the plants created at successive periods presupposes the admission of such a graduated scale.

It should also be noted that when we look at development from a botanical perspective, naturalists do not all agree on the existence of a clear hierarchy of organization in the plant world that parallels the generally accepted scale found in animals. As De Blainville said, "From the sponge to man," there may be a progressive chain of being, although it's often broken and imperfect; but if we try to classify plants in a linear sequence, gradually moving from lichen to lily or rose, we face significantly greater challenges. Still, the idea of increasingly advanced plant structures appearing over different periods assumes the existence of such a graduated scale.

We have as yet obtained but scanty information respecting the state of the terrestrial flora at periods antecedent to the coal. In the carboniferous 133 epoch, about 500 species of fossil plants are enumerated by Adolphe Brongniart, which we may safely regard as a mere fragment of an ancient flora; since, in Europe alone, there are now no less than 11,000 living species. I have already hinted that the plants which produced coal were not drifted from a distance, but that nearly all of them grew on the spots where they became fossil. They appear to have belonged, as before explained (p. 115), to a peculiar class of stations,—to low level and swampy regions, in the deltas of large rivers, slightly elevated above the level of the sea. From the study, therefore, of such a vegetation, we can derive but little insight into the nature of the contemporaneous upland flora, still less of the plants of the mountainous or Alpine country; and if so, we are enabled to account for the apparent monotony of the vegetation, although its uniform character was doubtless in part owing to a greater uniformity of climate then prevailing throughout the globe. Some of the commonest trees of this period, such as the sigillariæ, which united the structure of ferns and of cycadeæ, departed very widely from all known living types. The coniferæ and ferns, on the contrary, were very closely allied to living genera. It is remarkable that none of the exogens of Lindley (dicotyledonous angiosperms of Brongniart), which comprise four-fifths of the living flora of the globe, and include all the forest trees of Europe except the fir-tribe, have yet been discovered in the coal measures, and a very small number—fifteen species only—of monocotyledons. If several of these last are true plants, an opinion to which Messrs. Lindley, Unger, Corda, and other botanists of note incline, the question whether any of the most highly organized plants are to be met with in ancient strata is at once answered in the affirmative. But the determination of these palms being doubtful, we have as yet in the coal no positive proofs either of the existence of the most perfect, or of the most simple forms of flowering or flowerless vegetation. We have no fungi, lichens, hepatici or mosses: yet this latter class may have been as fully represented then as now.

We still have very little information about the state of land plants before the coal period. In the carboniferous 133 era, Adolphe Brongniart lists around 500 species of fossil plants, which we can consider just a small part of an ancient flora; in Europe alone, there are currently at least 11,000 living species. I've already suggested that the plants that created coal didn’t drift from afar, but nearly all of them grew right where they became fossilized. As previously mentioned (p. 115), they mainly belonged to specific types of environments—low, swampy areas in the deltas of large rivers, slightly above sea level. Therefore, from studying this type of vegetation, we can learn very little about the upland flora of the same time, and even less about the plants from mountainous or Alpine regions; this helps explain the apparent uniformity of the vegetation, although the overall uniform character was likely also due to a more consistent climate across the planet at that time. Some of the most common trees of this period, like the sigillariæ, which combined features of ferns and cycads, were very different from any known living types. In contrast, conifers and ferns were very similar to existing genera. It’s notable that none of Lindley’s exogens (the dicotyledonous angiosperms identified by Brongniart), which make up four-fifths of the planet's living flora and include all the forest trees of Europe except for the fir family, have been found in coal deposits, and only a very small number—just fifteen species—of monocotyledons have been identified. If several of these are indeed true plants, as some prominent botanists like Messrs. Lindley, Unger, and Corda believe, then the question of whether any of the most advanced plants are found in ancient layers is answered positively. However, since the identification of these palms is uncertain, we still lack clear evidence in the coal of either the most complex or the simplest forms of flowering or non-flowering plants. There are no fungi, lichens, liverworts, or mosses; though it's possible this last group was just as represented then as it is now.

In the flora of the secondary eras, all botanists agree that palms existed, although in Europe plants of the family of zamia and cycas together with coniferæ predominated, and must have given a peculiar aspect to the flora. As only 200 or 300 species of plants are known in all the rocks ranging from the Trias to the Oolite inclusive, our data are too scanty as yet to affirm whether the vegetation of this second epoch was or was not on the whole of a simpler organization than that of our own times.

In the plant life of the Mesozoic era, all botanists agree that palms were present, although in Europe, plants from the zamia and cycas families, along with conifers, dominated and likely shaped the unique character of the vegetation. Since only about 200 or 300 species of plants are identified in the rocks from the Triassic to the Oolite periods, our information is still too limited to determine whether the plant life of this era was generally simpler than that of today.

In the Lower Cretaceous formation, near Aix-la-Chapelle, the leaves of a great many dicotyledonous trees have lately been discovered by Dr. Debey, establishing the important fact of the coexistence of a large number of angiosperms with cycadeæ, and with that rich reptilian fauna comprising the ichthyosaur, plesiosaur, and pterodactyl, which some had supposed to indicate a state of the atmosphere unfavorable to a dicotyledonous vegetation.

In the Lower Cretaceous formation near Aix-la-Chapelle, Dr. Debey has recently discovered many leaves from different types of flowering trees. This finding is significant because it shows that a large number of angiosperms existed alongside cycads and a diverse group of reptiles, including ichthyosaurs, plesiosaurs, and pterodactyls. Some had thought that the presence of these reptiles suggested that the atmosphere was not suitable for flowering plants.

134The number of plants hitherto obtained from tertiary strata of different ages is very limited, but is rapidly increasing. They are referable to a much greater variety of families and classes than an equal number of fossil species taken from secondary or primary rocks, the angiosperms bearing the same proportion to the gymnosperms and acrogens as in the present flora of the globe. This greater variety may, doubtless, be partly ascribed to the greater diversity of stations in which the plants grew, as we have in this case an opportunity, rarely enjoyed in studying the secondary fossils, of investigating inland or lacustrine deposits accumulated at different heights above the sea, and containing the memorials of plants washed down from adjoining mountains.

134The number of plants we've found so far from tertiary layers of various ages is quite small, but it's growing quickly. They belong to a much broader range of families and classes than an equivalent number of fossil species from secondary or primary rocks, with angiosperms being represented in the same ratio to gymnosperms and acrogens as in today's global flora. This greater diversity can likely be attributed in part to the wider variety of environments where the plants thrived, as this situation offers a rare chance, unlike when studying secondary fossils, to examine inland or lake deposits that accumulated at various elevations above sea level, which include remnants of plants that were washed down from nearby mountains.

In regard, then, to the strata from the cretaceous to the uppermost tertiary inclusive, we may affirm that we find in them all the principal classes of living plants, and during this vast lapse of time four or five complete changes in the vegetation occurred, yet no step whatever was made in advance at any of these periods by the addition of more highly organized species.

In relation to the layers from the Cretaceous to the uppermost Tertiary inclusive, we can say that we see all the main types of living plants in them, and over this long period, four or five complete changes in vegetation took place. However, there was no progress at any of these times with the introduction of more advanced species.

If we next turn to the fossils of the animal kingdom, we may inquire whether, when they are arranged by the geologists in a chronological series, they imply that beings of more highly developed structure and greater intelligence entered upon the earth at successive epochs, those of the simplest organization being the first created, and those more highly organized being the last.

If we now look at the fossils of the animal kingdom, we can ask whether, when geologists arrange them in a chronological order, they suggest that more complex and intelligent beings appeared on Earth at different times, with the simplest forms being the first to exist and the more advanced ones coming later.

Our knowledge of the Silurian fauna is at present derived entirely from rocks of marine origin, no fresh-water strata of such high antiquity having yet been met with. The fossils, however, of these ancient rocks at once reduce the theory of progressive development to within very narrow limits, for already they comprise a very full representation of the radiata, mollusca, and articulata proper to the sea. Thus, in the great division of radiata, we find asteriod and helianthoid zoophytes, besides crinoid and cystidean echinoderms. In the mollusca, between 200 and 300 species of cephalopoda are enumerated. In the articulata we have the crustaceans represented by more than 200 species of trilobites, besides other genera of the same class. The remains of fish are as yet confined to the upper part of the Silurian series; but some of these belong to placoid fish, which occupy a high grade in the scale of organization. Some naturalists have assumed that the earliest fauna was exclusively marine, because we have not yet found a single Silurian helix, insect, bird, terrestrial reptile or mammifer; but when we carry back our investigation to a period so remote from the present, we ought not to be surprised if the only accessible strata should be limited to deposits formed far from land, because the ocean probably occupied then, as now, the greater part of the earth's surface. After so many entire geographical revolutions, the chances are nearly three to one in favor of our finding that such small portions of the existing continents and islands as expose Silurian strata to view, should coincide in position with the ancient ocean rather than the land. We must not, therefore, 135 too hastily infer, from the absence of fossil bones of mammalia in the older rocks, that the highest class of vertebrated animals did not exist in remoter ages. There are regions at present, in the Indian and Pacific Oceans, coextensive in area with the continents of Europe and North America, where we might dredge the bottom and draw up thousands of shells and corals, without obtaining one bone of a land quadruped. Suppose our mariners were to report, that, on sounding in the Indian Ocean near some coral reefs, and at some distance from the land, they drew up on hooks attached to their line portions of a leopard, elephant, or tapir, should we not be skeptical as to the accuracy of their statements? and if we had no doubt of their veracity, might we not suspect them to be unskilful naturalists? or, if the fact were unquestioned, should we not be disposed to believe that some vessel had been wrecked on the spot?

Our current understanding of Silurian fauna comes entirely from marine rocks, as we haven’t found any fresh-water layers from that ancient time. The fossils in these old rocks limit the theory of progressive development because they already include a wide variety of radiata, mollusks, and arthropods typical of the sea. In the major group of radiata, we see starfish and sea anemone-like creatures, along with crinoids and cystoids, which are types of echinoderms. Among mollusks, there are between 200 and 300 species of cephalopods. For arthropods, crustaceans are represented by over 200 species of trilobites and other genera in the same class. Fish remains are currently found only in the upper part of the Silurian series, but some of these are placoid fish, which are highly organized. Some scientists believe that the earliest fauna was solely marine, since we haven’t found a single Silurian snail, insect, bird, land reptile, or mammal; however, when we look back to such a distant time, we shouldn’t be surprised that the only available layers come from deposits formed far from land, as the ocean likely covered most of the Earth’s surface then, just as it does now. Given the many geographical changes over time, it’s almost three to one that the small parts of the existing continents and islands where Silurian layers are visible would be located over ancient ocean rather than land. Therefore, we shouldn’t quickly conclude, based on the absence of mammal fossils in older rocks, that the most advanced vertebrates didn’t exist in earlier ages. There are currently areas in the Indian and Pacific Oceans that are as large as the continents of Europe and North America, where we could dredge the seabed and bring up thousands of shells and corals without finding a single land animal bone. If our sailors were to report that, while fishing in the Indian Ocean near some coral reefs and distant from land, they caught parts of a leopard, elephant, or tapir on their hooks, would we not doubt their accuracy? And if we believed they were truthful, might we not question their skills as naturalists? Or if the fact was beyond doubt, wouldn’t we likely think that some ship had sunk there?

The casualties must always be rare by which land quadrupeds are swept by rivers far out into the open sea, and still rarer the contingency of such a floating body not being devoured by sharks or other predaceous fish, such as were those of which we find the teeth preserved in some of the carboniferous strata. But if the carcass should escape, and should happen to sink where sediment was in the act of accumulating, and if the numerous causes of subsequent disintegration should not efface all traces of the body, included for countless ages in solid rock, is it not contrary to all calculation of chances that we should hit upon the exact spot—that mere point in the bed of an ancient ocean, where the precious relic was entombed? Can we expect for a moment, when we have only succeeded, amidst several thousand fragments of corals and shells, in finding a few bones of aquatic or amphibious animals, that we should meet with a single skeleton of an inhabitant of the land?

The chances of land animals getting carried away by rivers and ending up far out in the open sea are always slim, and even rarer is the chance that such a floating body wouldn't be eaten by sharks or other predatory fish, like those whose teeth we've found preserved in some carboniferous layers. But if the carcass does manage to escape and sinks in an area where sediment is accumulating, and if various factors of decay don't completely erase all evidence of the body—trapped for countless ages in solid rock—how unlikely is it that we would find the exact spot, that specific point in the ancient ocean floor, where the valuable relic was buried? Can we really expect that, after sorting through thousands of fragments of corals and shells, we would discover even a single skeleton of a land-dwelling creature?

Clarence, in his dream, saw, "in the slimy bottom of the deep,"

Clarence, in his dream, saw, "in the slimy bottom of the deep,"

a thousand terrifying wrecks; A thousand men, whom the fish devoured: Gold wedges, large anchors, and piles of pearls.

Had he also beheld, amid "the dead bones that lay scattered by," the carcasses of lions, deer, and the other wild tenants of the forest and the plain, the fiction would have been deemed unworthy of the genius of Shakspeare. So daring a disregard of probability and violation of analogy would have been condemned as unpardonable, even where the poet was painting those incongruous images which present themselves to a disturbed imagination during the visions of the night.

Had he also seen, among "the dead bones that lay scattered around," the bodies of lions, deer, and other wild animals of the forest and plains, the story would have been considered unworthy of Shakespeare's genius. Such a blatant disregard for probability and violation of analogy would have been judged as unforgivable, even when the poet was depicting those mismatched images that arise in a troubled mind during dreams.

Until lately it was supposed that the old red sandstone, or Devonian rocks, contained no vertebrate remains except those of fish, but in 1850 the footprints of a chelonian, and in 1851 the skeleton of a reptile, allied both to the batrachians and lizards, were found in a sandstone of that age near Elgin in Scotland.212 Up to the year 1844 it was laid 136 down as a received dogma in many works of high authority in geology, that reptiles were not created until after the close of the carboniferous epoch. In the course of that year, however, Hermann Von Meyer announced the discovery, in the coal measures of Rhenish Bavaria, of a reptile, called by him Apateon, related to the salamanders; and in 1847 three species of another genus, called archegosaurus by Goldfuss, were obtained from the coal of Saarbrück, between Treves and Strasburg. The footprints of a large quadruped, probably batrachian, had also been observed by Dr. King in the carboniferous rocks of Pennsylvania in 1844. The first example of the bones of a reptile in the Coal of North America was detected so lately as September, 1852, by Mr. G. W. Dawson and myself in Nova Scotia. These remains, referred by Messrs. Wyman and Owen to a perennibranchiate batrachian, were met with in the interior of an erect fossil tree, apparently a sigillaria. They seem clearly to have been introduced together with sediment into the tree, during its submergence and after it had decayed and was standing as a hollow cylinder of bark, this bark being now converted into coal.

Until recently, it was believed that the old red sandstone, or Devonian rocks, contained no vertebrate remains except for fish. However, in 1850, footprints of a turtle and, in 1851, the skeleton of a reptile related to both amphibians and lizards were discovered in sandstone of that age near Elgin, Scotland.212 Up until 1844, many authoritative geological works stated that reptiles did not appear until after the carboniferous period ended. That year, though, Hermann Von Meyer announced the discovery of a reptile he named Apateon in the coal measures of Rhenish Bavaria, which was related to salamanders. In 1847, three species of another genus called archegosaurus by Goldfuss were found in the coal of Saarbrück, between Treves and Strasburg. Dr. King also observed the footprints of a large quadruped, likely amphibian, in the carboniferous rocks of Pennsylvania in 1844. The first example of reptile bones in the North American coal was only identified in September 1852 by Mr. G. W. Dawson and myself in Nova Scotia. These remains, which Messrs. Wyman and Owen attributed to a perennibranchiate amphibian, were discovered inside an upright fossil tree, likely a sigillaria. It appears they were introduced along with sediment into the tree during its submersion and after it had decayed, leaving it standing as a hollow bark cylinder, which has since become coal.

When Agassiz, in his great work on fossil fish, described 152 species of ichthyolites from the Coal, he found them to consist of 94 placoids, belonging to the families of shark and ray, and 58 ganoids. One family of the latter he called "sauroid fish," including the megalicthys and holoptychius, often of great size, and all predaceous. Although true fish, and not intermediate between that class and reptiles, they seem to have been more highly organized than any living fish, reminding us of the skeletons of saurians by the close suture of their cranial bones, their large conical teeth, striated longitudinally, and the articulation of the spinous processes with the vertebræ. Among living species they are most nearly allied to the lepidosteus, or bony pike of the North American rivers. Before the recent progress of discovery above alluded to had shown the fallacy of such ideas, it was imagined by some geologists that this ichthyic type was the more highly developed, because it took the lead at the head of nature before the class of reptiles had been created. The confident assumption indulged in till the year 1844, that reptiles were first introduced into the earth in the Permian period, shows the danger of taking for granted that the date of the creation of any family of animals or plants in past time coincides with the age of the oldest stratified rock in which the geologist has detected its remains. Nevertheless, after repeated disappointments, we find some naturalists as much disposed as ever to rely on such negative evidence, and to feel now as sure that reptiles were not introduced into the earth till after the Silurian epoch, as they were in 1844, that they appeared for the first time at an era subsequent to the carboniferous.

When Agassiz, in his major work on fossil fish, described 152 species of ichthyolites from the Coal period, he found them to consist of 94 placoids, which are part of the shark and ray families, and 58 ganoids. One family of the latter he called "sauroid fish," which included megalichthys and holoptychius, often large in size and all predatory. Although they are true fish and not intermediates between fish and reptiles, they appear to have been more advanced than any living fish, resembling the skeletons of reptiles because of the closely fitted cranial bones, their large conical teeth with longitudinal striations, and the way the spinous processes connect with the vertebrae. Among living species, they are most closely related to the lepidosteus, or bony pike, found in North American rivers. Before the recent advancements in discovery mentioned earlier highlighted the flaws in such ideas, some geologists believed that this fish type was more highly developed because it existed before reptiles were created. The confident assumption held until 1844 that reptiles first appeared on Earth during the Permian period indicates the risk of assuming that the timeline of any animal or plant family’s existence matches the age of the oldest rock layers where geologists have found its remains. Nevertheless, after numerous disappointments, we find some naturalists still as inclined as ever to depend on such negative evidence, feeling just as certain that reptiles did not appear until after the Silurian epoch, as they were in 1844, that they emerged for the first time after the carboniferous period.

Scanty as is the information hitherto obtained in regard to the articulata of the coal formation, we have at least ascertained that some insects winged their way through the ancient forests. In the ironstone of Coalbrook Dale, two species of coleoptera of the Linnæan genus curculio have been met with: and a neuropterous insect resembling a corydalis, 137 together with another of the same order related to the phasmidæ. As an example of the insectivorous arachnidæ, I may mention the scorpion of the Bohemian coal, figured by Count Sternberg, in which even the eyes, skin, and minute hairs were preserved.213 We need not despair, therefore, of obtaining eventually fossil representatives of all the principal orders of hexapods and arachnidæ in carboniferous strata.

Although the information we've gathered so far about the insects from the coal formation is limited, we do know that some insects flew through the ancient forests. In the ironstone of Coalbrook Dale, two species of beetles from the Linnæan genus Curculio have been found, along with a neuropteran insect that resembles a corydalis, and another insect from the same order related to the phasmids. As an example of insect-eating arachnids, I can mention the scorpion from the Bohemian coal, illustrated by Count Sternberg, in which even the eyes, skin, and tiny hairs were preserved.137213 Therefore, we shouldn't lose hope of eventually discovering fossil representatives of all the major orders of hexapods and arachnids in carboniferous layers.

Next in chronological order above the Coal comes the allied Magnesian Limestone, or Permian group, and the secondary formations from the Trias to the Chalk inclusive. These rocks comprise the monuments of a long series of ages in which reptiles of every variety of size, form, and structure peopled the earth; so that the whole period, and especially that of the Lias and Oolite, has been sometimes called "the age of reptiles." As there are now mammalia entirely confined to the land; others which, like the bat and vampire, fly in the air; others, again, of amphibious habits, frequenting rivers, like the hippopotamus, otter, and beaver; others exclusively aquatic and marine, like the seal, whale, and narwal; so in the early ages under consideration, there were terrestrial, winged, and aquatic reptiles. There were iguanodons walking on the land, pterodactyls winging their way through the air, monitors and crocodiles in the rivers, and ichthyosaurs and plesiosaurs in the ocean. It appears also that some of these ancient saurians approximated more nearly in their organization to the type of living mammalia than do any of the reptiles now existing.214

Next in the timeline above the Coal is the associated Magnesian Limestone, or Permian group, along with the secondary formations from the Trias to the Chalk. These rocks hold the history of a long series of ages in which reptiles of all sizes, shapes, and structures roamed the earth; thus, the entire period, especially during the Lias and Oolite, has often been referred to as "the age of reptiles." Just as there are now mammals that live solely on land, some like bats and vampires that fly, others like the hippopotamus, otter, and beaver that are amphibious and frequent rivers, and still others like the seal, whale, and narwhal that are entirely aquatic, there were also terrestrial, flying, and aquatic reptiles in those early ages. Iguanodons walked on land, pterodactyls soared through the skies, monitors and crocodiles inhabited the rivers, and ichthyosaurs and plesiosaurs swam in the ocean. It also seems that some of these ancient reptiles were more closely related in their structure to modern mammals than any reptiles that exist today.214

In the vast range of strata above alluded to, comprising the Permian, the Upper New Red Sandstone and Muschelkalk, the Lias, Oolite, Wealden, Green-sand, and Chalk, scarcely any well-authenticated instances of the occurrence of fossil birds in Europe are on record, and only two or three of fossil mammalia.

In the wide range of layers mentioned above, which includes the Permian, Upper New Red Sandstone, Muschelkalk, Lias, Oolite, Wealden, Green-sand, and Chalk, there are hardly any verified cases of fossil birds found in Europe, and only two or three instances of fossil mammals.

In regard to the absence of birds, they are usually wanting, for reasons afterwards to be explained (see chap. 47), in deposits of all ages, even in the tertiary periods, where we know that birds as well as land quadrupeds abounded. Some at least of the fossil remains formerly referred to this class in the Wealden (a great freshwater deposit below the chalk), have been recently shown by Mr. Owen to belong to pterodactyls.215 But in North America still more ancient indications of the existence of the feathered tribe have been detected, the fossil foot-marks of a great variety of species, of various sizes, some larger than the ostrich, others smaller than the plover, having been observed. These bipeds have left marks of their footsteps on strata of an age decidedly intermediate between the Lias and the Coal.216

Regarding the absence of birds, they are often missing, for reasons that will be explained later (see chap. 47). This is true in deposits of all ages, even during the tertiary periods, when we know that birds, as well as land mammals, were abundant. Some of the fossil remains that were previously classified as belonging to this group in the Wealden (a large freshwater deposit beneath the chalk) have recently been identified by Mr. Owen as belonging to pterodactyls.215 In North America, even older evidence of the existence of birds has been found, with fossil footprints from a variety of species of different sizes, some larger than an ostrich and others smaller than a plover. These bipedal creatures have left traces of their footprints on layers of rock that are clearly from a time between the Lias and the Coal.216

Fig. 8. Natural Size.           
Thylacotherium Prevostii.
Thylacotherium Prevostii (Valenciennes). Amphitherium (Owen). Lower jaw, from the slate of Stonesfield, near Oxford.218

The examples of mammalia, above alluded to, are confined to the Trias and the Oolite. In the former, the evidence is as yet limited to two small molar teeth, described by Professor Plieninger in 1847, under the 138 generic name of Microlestes. They were found near Stuttgart, and possess the double fangs so characteristic of mammalia.217 The other fossil remains of the same class were derived from one of the inferior members of the oolitic series in Oxfordshire, and afford more full and satisfactory evidence, consisting of the lower jaws of three species of small quadrupeds about the size of a mole. Cuvier, when he saw one of them (during a visit to Oxford in 1818), referred it to the marsupial order, stating, however, that it differed from all known carnivora in having ten molar teeth in a row. Professor Owen afterwards pointed out that the jaw belonged to an extinct genus, having considerable affinity to a newly discovered Australian mammifer, the Myrmecobius of Waterhouse, which has nine molar teeth in the lower jaw. (Fig. 9.) A more perfect specimen Fig. 9.Myrmecobius fasciatus. Myrmecobius fasciatus (Waterhouse). Recent from Swan River. Lower jaw of the natural size. 219 enabled Mr. Owen in 1846 to prove that the inflection of the angular process of the lower jaw was not sufficiently marked to entitle the osteologist to infer that this quadruped was marsupial, as the process is not bent inwards in a greater degree than in the mole or hedgehog. Hence the genus amphitherium, of which there are two species from Stonesfield, must be referred to the ordinary or placental 139 type of insectivorous mammals, although it approximates in some points of structure to the myrmecobius and allied marsupials of Australia. The other contemporary genus, called phascolotherium, agrees much more nearly in osteological character and precisely in the number of the teeth with the opossums; and is believed to have been truly marsupial. (Fig. 10.)

The examples of mammals mentioned earlier are limited to the Triassic and the Oolite periods. In the Triassic, the evidence is confined to two small molar teeth described by Professor Plieninger in 1847, under the generic name Microlestes. These were found near Stuttgart and feature the double fangs typical of mammals.217 The other fossil remains of this group came from one of the lower members of the Oolitic series in Oxfordshire, providing more complete and satisfactory evidence, including the lower jaws of three species of small quadrupeds about the size of a mole. Cuvier, when he examined one of them during a visit to Oxford in 1818, categorized it as a marsupial, noting that it was distinct from all known carnivores due to having ten molar teeth in a row. Professor Owen later pointed out that the jaw belonged to an extinct genus, which was closely related to a newly discovered Australian mammal, the Myrmecobius of Waterhouse, which has nine molar teeth in its lower jaw. (Fig. 9.) A more complete specimen allowed Mr. Owen in 1846 to demonstrate that the angle of the lower jaw was not curved enough to conclude that this quadruped was marsupial, as the angle is not bent inwards any more than in moles or hedgehogs. Therefore, the genus Amphitherium, which has two species from Stonesfield, should be classified among the typical placental insectivorous mammals, even though it shares some structural similarities with Myrmecobius and allied marsupials from Australia. The other contemporary genus, named Phascolotherium, is much closer in skeletal features and precisely matches the tooth count of opossums, and it is believed to have indeed been a marsupial. (Fig. 10.)

Fig. 10.Phascolotherium Bucklandi,

Natural size.
Phascolotherium Bucklandi, Owen. (Syn. Didelphis Bucklandi, Brod.) Lower jaw, from Stonesfield.220

Natural size.
Phascolotherium Bucklandi, Owen. (Syn. Didelphis Bucklandi, Brod.) Lower jaw, from Stonesfield.220

1. The jaw magnified twice in length.   2. The second molar tooth magnified six times.

1. The jaw grew twice as long. 2. The second molar tooth grew six times larger.

The occurrence of these most ancient memorials of the mammiferous type, in so low a member of the oolitic series, while no other representatives of the same class (if we except the microlestes) have yet been found in any other of the inferior or superior secondary strata, is a striking fact, and should serve as a warning to us against hasty generalizations, founded solely on negative evidence. So important an exception to a general rule may be perfectly consistent with the conclusion, that a small number only of mammalia inhabited European latitudes when our secondary rocks were formed; but it seems fatal to the theory of progressive development, or to the notion that the order of precedence in the creation of animals, considered chronologically, has precisely coincided with the order in which they would be ranked according to perfection or complexity of structure.

The presence of these ancient mammal fossils in a lower part of the oolitic series, while no other similar fossils (except for the microlestes) have been discovered in any other lower or upper secondary strata, is a notable fact and should caution us against jumping to conclusions based solely on what we don't find. This important exception to a general rule may support the idea that only a small number of mammals lived in European regions when our secondary rocks were formed; however, it seems to contradict the theory of progressive development or the idea that the order in which animals were created, chronologically, aligns perfectly with their ranking based on how advanced or complex their structures are.

It was for many years suggested that the marsupial order to which the fossil animals of Stonesfield were supposed exclusively to belong constitutes the lowest grade in the class Mammalia, and that this order, of which the brain is of more simple form, evinces an inferior degree of 140 intelligence. If, therefore, in the oolitic period the marsupial tribes were the only warm-blooded quadrupeds which had as yet appeared upon our planet, the fact, it was said, confirmed the theory which teaches that the creation of the more simple forms in each division of the animal kingdom preceded that of the more complex. But on how slender a support, even if the facts had continued to hold true, did such important conclusions hang! The Australian continent, so far as it has been hitherto explored, contains no indigenous quadrupeds save those of the marsupial order, with the exception of a few small rodents, while some neighboring islands to the north, and even southern Africa, in the same latitude as Australia, abound in mammalia of every tribe except the marsupial. We are entirely unable to explain on what physiological or other laws this singular diversity in the habitations of living mammalia depends; but nothing is more clear than that the causes which stamp so peculiar a character on two different provinces of wide extent are wholly independent of time, or of the age or maturity of the planet.

For many years, it was believed that the marsupial order to which the fossil animals of Stonesfield were thought to exclusively belong represents the lowest level in the class Mammalia, and that this order, with its simpler brain structure, shows a lower degree of intelligence. If, therefore, during the oolitic period the marsupial groups were the only warm-blooded quadrupeds to appear on our planet, this fact was said to support the theory that simpler forms in each category of the animal kingdom emerged before more complex ones. But how flimsy a foundation such significant conclusions rested on, even if the facts had remained accurate! The Australian continent, as far as it has been explored, contains no native quadrupeds except for those of the marsupial order, apart from a few small rodents, while some nearby islands to the north, and even southern Africa at the same latitude as Australia, are rich in mammals from every group except marsupials. We have no clue how this unusual diversity in mammal habitats comes about under physiological or other laws; however, it is evident that the causes creating such a unique distinction between two vast regions are completely separate from time or the age or development of the planet.

The strata of the Wealden, although of a later date than the oolite of Stonesfield, and although filled with the remains of large reptiles, both terrestrial and aquatic, have not yielded as yet a single marsupial bone. Were we to assume on such scanty data that no warm-blooded quadrupeds were then to be found throughout the northern hemisphere, there would still remain a curious subject of speculation, whether the entire suppression of one important class of vertebrata, such as the mammiferous, and the great development of another, such as the reptilian, implies a departure from fixed and uniform rules governing the fluctuations of the animal world; such rules, for example, as appear from one century to another to determine the growth of certain tribes of plants and animals in arctic, and of other tribes in tropical regions.

The layers of the Wealden, though more recent than the oolite of Stonesfield and full of the remains of large reptiles, both land and sea, have yet to produce a single marsupial bone. If we were to conclude from such limited evidence that there were no warm-blooded mammals present in the northern hemisphere at that time, it still raises an interesting question: does the complete absence of one crucial group of vertebrates, like mammals, along with the significant presence of another group, like reptiles, indicate a deviation from the consistent and uniform patterns that govern the changes in the animal kingdom? These patterns, for instance, seem to dictate the flourishing of certain species of plants and animals in Arctic regions and different species in tropical areas.

In Australia, New Zealand, and many other parts of the southern hemisphere, where the indigenous land quadrupeds are comparatively few, and of small dimensions, the reptiles do not predominate in number or size. The deposits formed at the mouth of an Australian river, within the tropics, might contain the bones of only a few small marsupial animals, which, like those of Stonesfield, might hereafter be discovered with difficulty by geologists; but there would, at the same time, be no megalosauri and other fossil remains, showing that large saurians were plentiful on the land and in the waters at a time when mammalia were scarce. This example, therefore, would afford a very imperfect parallel to the state of the animal kingdom, supposed to have prevailed during the secondary periods, when a high temperature pervaded European latitudes.

In Australia, New Zealand, and many other areas in the southern hemisphere, where there are relatively few indigenous land mammals of small size, reptiles are also not abundant in number or size. The sediment formed at the mouth of an Australian river, within the tropics, might only include the bones of a few small marsupial animals, which could be difficult for geologists to find later, much like those from Stonesfield; however, there wouldn’t be any megalosaurs or other fossil remains indicating that large reptiles were widespread on land and in the waters at a time when mammals were rare. This example, therefore, does not accurately reflect the condition of the animal kingdom that likely existed during the secondary periods, when there was a high temperature across European regions.

It may nevertheless be advantageous to point to some existing anomalies in the geographical development of distinct classes of vertebrata which may be comparable to former conditions of the animal creation brought to light by geology. Thus in the arctic regions, at present, reptiles are small, and sometimes wholly wanting, where birds, large land quadrupeds, and cetacea abound. We meet with bears, wolves, 141 foxes, musk oxen, and deer, walruses, seals, whales, and narwals, in regions of ice and snow, where the smallest snakes, efts, and frogs are rarely, if ever, seen.

It may still be useful to highlight some existing oddities in the geographical distribution of different classes of vertebrates that might mirror previous states of animal life revealed by geology. For example, in the Arctic regions today, reptiles are small and sometimes completely absent, while large birds, big land mammals, and whales are plentiful. We find bears, wolves, 141 foxes, musk oxen, and deer, along with walruses, seals, whales, and narwhals, in icy and snowy areas, where the smallest snakes, newts, and frogs are rarely, if ever, seen.

A still more anomalous state of things presents itself in the southern hemisphere. Even in the temperate zone, between the latitudes 52° and 56° S., as, for example, in Tierra del Fuego, as well as in the woody region immediately north of the Straits of Magellan, and in the Falkland Islands, no reptiles of any kind are met with, not even a snake, lizard, or frog; but in these same countries we find the guanaco (a kind of llama), a deer, the puma, a large species of fox, many small rodentia, besides the seal and otter, together with the porpoise, whale, and other cetacea.

A more unusual situation arises in the southern hemisphere. Even in the temperate zone, between latitudes 52° and 56° S, like in Tierra del Fuego, the forested area just north of the Straits of Magellan, and the Falkland Islands, there are no reptiles at all—no snakes, lizards, or frogs. Yet, in these same places, we find the guanaco (a type of llama), a deer, the puma, a large type of fox, many small rodents, as well as seals, otters, porpoises, whales, and other cetaceans.

On what grand laws in the animal physiology these remarkable phenomena depend, cannot in the present state of science be conjectured; nor could we predict whether any opposite condition of the atmosphere, in respect to heat, moisture, and other circumstances, would bring about a state of animal life which might be called the converse of that above described, namely, a state in which reptiles of every size and order might abound, and mammalia disappear.

On what major rules in animal physiology these amazing phenomena depend is something that can't be guessed at with our current scientific understanding; nor can we anticipate whether a different atmospheric condition, in terms of temperature, humidity, and other factors, would create an opposite state of animal life, where reptiles of all sizes and types might thrive while mammals vanish.

The nearest approximation to such a fauna is found in the Galapagos Archipelago. These islands, situated under the equator, and nearly 600 miles west of the coast of Peru, have been called "the land of reptiles," so great is the number of snakes, large tortoises, and lizards, which they support. Among the lizards, the first living species proper to the ocean has been discovered. Yet, although some of these islands are from 3000 to 4000 feet high, and one of them 75 miles long, they contain, with the exception of one small mouse, no indigenous mammifer. Even here, however, it is true that in the neighboring sea there are seals, and several kinds of cetacea.221

The closest example of such wildlife is found in the Galapagos Archipelago. These islands, located just south of the equator and about 600 miles west of the coast of Peru, are often referred to as "the land of reptiles" because of the abundance of snakes, large tortoises, and lizards that inhabit them. Among the lizards, the first true ocean species has been identified. However, despite some of these islands rising to heights of 3000 to 4000 feet, and one stretching 75 miles long, they have no native mammals except for one small mouse. Nonetheless, it is true that in the surrounding sea, there are seals and various types of whales.221

It may be unreasonable to look for a nearer analogy between the fauna now existing in any part of the globe, and that which we can show to have prevailed when our secondary strata were deposited, because we must always recollect that a climate like that now experienced at the equator, coexisting with the unequal days and nights of European latitudes, was a state of things to which there is now no counterpart on the globe. Consequently, the type of animal and vegetable existence required for such a climate might be expected to deviate almost as widely from that now established, as do the flora and fauna of our tropical differ from those of our arctic regions.

It might be unreasonable to expect a closer comparison between the wildlife currently found anywhere in the world and that which existed when our secondary layers of rock were formed. We must remember that a climate like what we experience at the equator, alongside the varying lengths of day and night in European regions, is something that has no equivalent anywhere on Earth today. As a result, the types of animals and plants that thrived in such a climate would likely differ just as much from today's species as the tropical plants and animals differ from those in our Arctic regions.

In the Tertiary strata.—The tertiary formations were deposited when the physical geography of the northern hemisphere had been entirely altered. Large inland lakes had become numerous, as in central France and other countries. There were gulfs of the sea, into which considerable rivers emptied themselves, and where strata like those of the Paris basin were accumulated. There were also formations in progress, in 142 shallow seas not far from shore, such as are indicated by portions of the Faluns of the Loire, and the English Crag.

In the Tertiary layers.—The Tertiary formations were laid down when the northern hemisphere's physical geography had completely changed. Large inland lakes became common, as seen in central France and other regions. There were gulfs where significant rivers flowed into the sea, and where layers similar to those in the Paris basin formed. There were also formations developing in 142 shallow seas close to the shore, as indicated by parts of the Faluns of the Loire and the English Crag.

The proximity, therefore, of large tracts of dry land to the seas and lakes then existing, may, in a great measure, explain why the remains of land animals, so rare in the older strata, are not uncommon in these more modern deposits. Yet even these have sometimes proved entirely destitute of mammiferous relics for years after they had become celebrated for the abundance of their fossil testacea, fish, and reptiles. Thus the calcaire grossier, a marine limestone of the district round Paris, had afforded to collectors more than 1100 species of shells, besides many zoophytes, echinodermata, and the teeth of fish, before the bones of one or two land quadrupeds were met with in the same rock. The strata called London and Plastic clay in England have been studied for more than half a century, and about 400 species of shells, 50 or more of fish, besides several kinds of chelonian and saurian reptiles, were known before a single mammifer was detected. At length, in the year 1839, there were found in this formation the remains of a monkey, an opossum, a bat,222 and a species of the extinct genus Hyracotherium, allied to the Peccary or hog tribe.

The closeness of large areas of dry land to the seas and lakes that existed at the time helps explain why the remains of land animals, which are rare in older layers, are more common in these newer deposits. However, even these deposits sometimes lacked mammal remains for years, even though they became famous for having a lot of fossil shells, fish, and reptiles. For example, the calcaire grossier, a marine limestone around Paris, provided collectors with more than 1100 species of shells, along with many types of zoophytes, echinoderms, and fish teeth, before one or two land mammals were found in the same rock. The layers known as London and Plastic clay in England have been studied for over fifty years, and about 400 shell species, 50 or more fish species, and several kinds of turtles and lizards were known before a single mammal was identified. Finally, in 1839, remains of a monkey, an opossum, a bat,222 and a species of the extinct genus Hyracotherium, related to the peccary or hog family, were found in this formation.

If we examine the strata above the London clay in England, we first meet with mammiferous remains in the Isle of Wight, in beds also belonging to the Eocene epoch, such as the remains of the Palæotherium, Anoplotherium, and other extinct quadrupeds, agreeing very closely with those first found by Cuvier, near Paris, in strata of the same age, and of similar freshwater origin.

If we look at the layers above the London clay in England, we first find mammal remains on the Isle of Wight, in deposits that also date back to the Eocene epoch. These include remains of the Palæotherium, Anoplotherium, and other extinct four-legged animals, which are very similar to those first discovered by Cuvier near Paris, in layers of the same age and from similar freshwater sources.

In France we meet with another fauna, both conchological and mammalian in the Miocene "faluns" of the Loire; above which in the ascending series in Great Britain we arrive at the coralline crag of Suffolk, a marine formation which has yielded three or four hundred species of shells, very different from the Eocene testacea, and of which a large proportion, although a minority of the whole number, are recent, besides many corals, echini, foraminifera, and fish, but as yet no relic decidedly mammalian except the ear-bone of a whale.

In France, we encounter a different set of wildlife, both shellfish and mammals, in the Miocene "faluns" of the Loire. As we move up the geological layers in Great Britain, we reach the coralline crag of Suffolk, a marine formation that has produced three or four hundred species of shells, which are quite different from the Eocene sea creatures. A significant portion of these, while still a minority of the total, are modern, along with many corals, sea urchins, foraminifera, and fish. However, we have yet to find any clear mammal remains, except for the ear bone of a whale.

In the shelly sand, provincially termed "Red Crag," in Suffolk, which immediately succeeds the coralline, constituting a newer member of the same tertiary group, about 250 species of shells have been recognized, of which a still larger proportion are recent. They are associated with numerous teeth of fish; but no signs of a warm-blooded quadruped had been detected until 1839, when the teeth of a leopard, a bear, a hog, and a species of ruminant, were found at Newbourn, in Suffolk, and since that time, several other genera of mammalia have been met with in the same formation, or in the Red Crag.223

In the sandy area known locally as "Red Crag" in Suffolk, which comes right after the coralline and is a newer part of the same tertiary group, about 250 species of shells have been identified, with many of them being recent. These shells are found alongside various fish teeth; however, no evidence of warm-blooded four-legged animals was found until 1839, when teeth from a leopard, a bear, a pig, and a type of grazing animal were discovered in Newbourn, Suffolk. Since then, several other types of mammals have been found in the same formation or in the Red Crag.223

Of a still newer date is the Norwich Crag, a fluvio-marine deposit of the Pleiocene epoch, containing a mixture of marine, fluviatile, and land 143 shells, of which 90 per cent. or more are recent. These beds, since the time of their first investigation, have yielded a supply of mammalian bones of the genera mastodon, elephant, rhinoceros, pig, horse, deer, ox, and others, the bodies of which may have been washed down into the sea by rivers draining land, of which the contiguity is indicated by the occasional presence of terrestrial and freshwater shells.

Of a more recent origin is the Norwich Crag, a fluvial-marine deposit from the Pleistocene epoch, consisting of a mix of marine, river, and land 143 shells, over 90 percent of which are recent. Since its initial study, these layers have provided a range of mammal bones from genera such as mastodon, elephant, rhinoceros, pig, horse, deer, ox, and others. These animals may have been washed into the sea by rivers draining nearby land, as indicated by the occasional presence of land and freshwater shells.

Our acquaintance with the newer Pleiocene mammalia in Europe, South America, and Australia, is derived chiefly from cavern deposits, a fact which we ought never to forget if we desire to appreciate the superior facilities we enjoy for studying the more modern as compared to the more ancient terrestrial faunas. We know nothing of the fossil bones which must have been inclosed in the stalagmite of caverns in the older Pleiocene, or in the Miocene or Eocene epochs, much less can we derive any information respecting the inhabitants of the land from a similar source, when we carry back our inquiries to the Wealden or carboniferous epochs. We are as well assured that land and rivers then existed, as that they exist now; but it is evident that even a slight geographical revolution, accompanied by the submergence and denudation of land, would reduce to an extreme improbability the chance of our hitting on those minute points of space where caves may once have occurred in limestone rocks.

Our knowledge of the more recent Pleistocene mammals in Europe, South America, and Australia mainly comes from cave deposits. This is something we should always keep in mind if we want to truly appreciate how much easier it is to study the more recent faunas compared to the ancient ones. We don’t know anything about the fossil bones that must have been trapped in the stalagmite of caves during the older Pleistocene, or in the Miocene or Eocene periods. Even less can we learn about the land's inhabitants from similar sources when we look back at the Wealden or Carboniferous periods. We are confident that land and rivers existed then just as they do now, but it’s clear that even a slight geographical change, along with the sinking and erosion of land, would make it incredibly unlikely for us to find those specific locations where caves may have once been in limestone formations.

Fossil quadrumana.—Until within a few years (1836, 1837), not a single bone of any quadrumanous animal, such as the orang, ape, baboon, and monkey, had been discovered in a fossil state, although so much progress had been made in bringing to light the extinct mammalia of successive tertiary eras, both carnivorous and herbivorous. The total absence of these anthropomorphous tribes among the records of a former world, had led some to believe that the type of organization most nearly resembling the human, came so late in the order of creation, as to be scarcely, if at all, anterior to that of man. That such generalizations were premature, I endeavored to point out in the first edition of this work,224 in which I stated that the bones of quadrupeds hitherto met with in tertiary deposits were chiefly those which frequent marshes, rivers, or the borders of lakes, as the elephant, rhinoceros, hippopotamus, tapir, hog, deer, and ox, while species which live in trees are extremely rare in a fossil state. I also hinted, that we had as yet no data for determining how great a number of the one kind we ought to find, before we have a right to expect a single individual of the other. Lastly, I observed that the climate of the more modern (or Post-Eocene) tertiary periods in England was not tropical, and that in regard to the London clay, of which the crocodiles, turtles, and fossil fruits implied a climate hot enough for the quadrumana, we had as yet made too little progress in ascertaining what were the Eocene pachydermata of England, to entitle us to expect to have discovered any quadrumana of the same date.

Fossil quadrumana.—Until a few years ago (1836, 1837), no bones of any primate, such as the orangutan, ape, baboon, or monkey, had been found in a fossil state, even though significant progress had been made in uncovering extinct mammals from various tertiary eras, both carnivorous and herbivorous. The complete lack of these human-like groups in the records of an earlier world led some to believe that the primates most similar to humans appeared so late in the timeline of creation that they were barely, if at all, prior to humans. I aimed to show that such conclusions were hasty in the first edition of this work,224 where I noted that the bones of quadrupeds discovered in tertiary deposits mainly belonged to animals that inhabited marshes, rivers, or lake shores, such as elephants, rhinoceroses, hippopotamuses, tapirs, pigs, deer, and oxen, while tree-dwelling species are extremely rare in the fossil record. I also pointed out that we did not yet have enough information to determine how many of one type we should find before we could reasonably expect to discover even one of the other type. Finally, I mentioned that the climate in the more modern (or Post-Eocene) tertiary periods in England was not tropical, and regarding the London clay, where the presence of crocodiles, turtles, and fossil fruits suggested a climate warm enough for primates, we had not yet made sufficient progress in identifying the Eocene pachyderms of England to justify expecting to have found any primates from that same period.

Since those remarks were first written, in 1829, a great number of extinct species have been added to our collections of tertiary mammalia 144 from Great Britain and other parts of the world. At length, between the years 1836 and 1839, a few remains of quadrumana were found in France and England, India and Brazil. Those of India, belonging to more than one extinct species of monkey, were first discovered near the Sutlej, in lat. 30° N., in tertiary strata, of which the age is not yet determined; the Brazilian fossil, brought from the basin of the Rio das Velhas, about lat. 18° S., is referable to a form now peculiar in America, allied to the genus Callithrix, the species being extinct. The skull and other bones met with in the South of France belong to a gibbon, or one of the tailless apes, which stand next in the scale of organization to the orang. It occurred at Sansan, about forty miles west of Toulouse, in lat. 43° 40' N., in freshwater strata, probably of the Miocene or middle tertiary period. Lastly, the English quadrumane first met with, occurred in a more ancient stratum than the rest, and at a point more remote from the equator. It belongs to the genus Macacus, is an extinct species, and was found in Suffolk, in lat. 52°,225 in the London clay, the fossils of which, such as crocodiles, turtles, shells of the genus Nautilus, and many curious fruits, had already led geologists to the conclusion that the climate of that era (the Eocene) was warm and nearly tropical.

Since those comments were first made in 1829, a significant number of extinct species have been added to our collections of tertiary mammals 144 from Great Britain and other parts of the world. Finally, between 1836 and 1839, a few remains of primates were found in France, England, India, and Brazil. The remains from India, representing more than one extinct species of monkey, were first discovered near the Sutlej River, at latitude 30° N, in tertiary layers, whose age remains undetermined; the Brazilian fossil, collected from the basin of the Rio das Velhas, around latitude 18° S, corresponds to a form now unique to America, related to the genus Callithrix, which is extinct. The skull and other bones found in the south of France belong to a gibbon, or one of the tailless apes, which are next in the evolutionary scale to the orangutan. This was found at Sansan, about forty miles west of Toulouse, at latitude 43° 40' N, in freshwater layers, likely from the Miocene or middle tertiary period. Lastly, the English primate discovered was found in an older layer than the others and at a location further from the equator. It belongs to the genus Macacus, is an extinct species, and was discovered in Suffolk, at latitude 52°, in the London clay, which contained fossils like crocodiles, turtles, Nautilus shells, and many unusual fruits, leading geologists to conclude that the climate of that time (the Eocene) was warm and nearly tropical.

Some years later (in 1846) the jaw of another British species of fossil monkey, Macacus pliocenus, was announced by Mr. Owen as having been met with in the newer Pleiocene strata, on the banks of the Thames, at Grays, in Essex, accompanying the remains of hippopotamus, elephant, and other quadrupeds, and associated with freshwater and land shells, most of which are now inhabitants of the British Isles.226

Some years later (in 1846), Mr. Owen announced the jaw of another British species of fossil monkey, Macacus pliocenus, discovered in the newer Pliocene layers along the Thames at Grays, Essex. It was found alongside the remains of hippopotamus, elephant, and other four-legged animals, as well as freshwater and land shells, most of which are now found in the British Isles.226

When we consider the small area of the earth's surface hitherto explored geologically, and the new discoveries brought to light daily, even in the environs of great European capitals, we must feel that it would be rash to assume that the Lower Eocene deposits mark the era of the first creation of quadrumana. It would, however, be still 145 more unphilosophical to infer, as some writers have done, from a single extinct species of this family obtained in a latitude far from the tropics, that the Eocene quadrumana did not attain as high a grade of organization as they do in our own times. What would the naturalist know of the apes and orangs now contemporary with man, if our investigations were restricted to such northern latitudes as those where alone the geologist has hitherto found all the fossil quadrumana of Europe?

When we look at the small area of the earth's surface that has been explored geologically so far, and the new discoveries that come to light every day, even around major European capitals, we must acknowledge that it would be reckless to assume that the Lower Eocene deposits represent the time of the first appearance of primates. It would, however, be even more unscientific to conclude, as some writers have, from just one extinct species of this family found in a latitude far from the tropics, that Eocene primates didn't reach as high a level of development as they do today. What would a naturalist know about the apes and orangutans that exist alongside humans now if our research was limited to northern latitudes where geologists have only found fossil primates in Europe?

Cetacea.—The absence of Cetacea from rocks older than the Eocene has been frequently adduced as lending countenance to the theory of the very late appearance of the highest class of Vertebrata on the earth. Professor Sedgwick possesses in the Cambridge Museum a mass of anchylosed cervical vertebræ of a whale, which he found in drift clay near Ely, and which he has no doubt was washed out of the Kimmeridge clay, an upper member of the Oolite. According to Professor Owen, it exhibits well-marked specific characters, distinguishing it from all other known recent or fossil cetacea. Dr. Leidy, of Philadelphia, has lately described (1851) two species of cetacea of a new genus, which he has called Priscodelphinus from the green sand of New Jersey, which corresponds in age with the English Chalk or the cretaceous strata above the gault. The specimens consist of dorsal and cervical vertebræ.227 Even in the Eocene strata of Europe, the discovery of cetaceans has never kept pace with that of land quadrupeds. The only instance cited in Great Britain is a species of Monodon, from the London clay, of doubtful authenticity as to its geological position. On the other hand, the gigantic Zeuglodon of North America occurs abundantly in the Middle Eocene strata of Georgia and Alabama, from which as yet no bones of land quadrupeds have been obtained.

Cetacea.—The lack of Cetacea in rocks older than the Eocene has often been used to support the idea that the highest class of vertebrates appeared very late on Earth. Professor Sedgwick has in the Cambridge Museum a collection of fused cervical vertebrae from a whale, which he found in drift clay near Ely, and he is confident it was eroded from the Kimmeridge clay, a higher layer of the Oolite. According to Professor Owen, it shows clear specific features that set it apart from all other known modern or fossil cetaceans. Dr. Leidy from Philadelphia recently described (1851) two species of cetacea from a new genus, which he named Priscodelphinus, found in the green sand of New Jersey, dating it to the same period as the English Chalk or the cretaceous layers above the gault. The specimens include dorsal and cervical vertebrae.227 Even in the Eocene layers of Europe, the discovery of cetaceans hasn't matched that of land mammals. The only example mentioned in Great Britain is a species of Monodon, from the London clay, whose geological authenticity is uncertain. In contrast, the massive Zeuglodon from North America is found abundantly in the Middle Eocene layers of Georgia and Alabama, where no bones of land mammals have been discovered yet.

In the present imperfect state then of our information, we can scarcely say more than that the cetacea seem to have been scarce in the secondary and primary periods. It is quite conceivable that when aquatic saurians, some of them carnivorous, like the Ichthyosaurus, were swarming in the sea, and when there were large herbivorous reptiles, like the Iguanodon, on the land, the class of reptiles may, to a certain extent, have superseded the cetacea, and discharged their functions in the animal economy.

In our current limited understanding, we can hardly say more than that whales and dolphins seem to have been rare during the secondary and primary periods. It's quite possible that when aquatic reptiles, some of them meat-eaters like the Ichthyosaurus, were abundant in the sea, and when there were large plant-eating reptiles like the Iguanodon on land, reptiles may have somewhat replaced cetaceans and taken over their roles in the ecosystem.

That mammalia had been created long before the epoch of the Kimmeridge clay, is shown by the Microlestes of the Trias before alluded to, and by the Stonesfield quadrupeds from the Inferior Oolite. And we are bound to remember, whenever we infer the poverty of the flora or fauna of any given period of the past, from the small number of fossils occurring in ancient rocks, that it has been evidently no part of the plan of Nature to hand down to us a complete or systematic record of the former history of the animate world. We may have failed to discover a single shell, marine or freshwater, or a single coral or bone in certain sandstones, such as that of the valley of the Connecticut, where the footprints of bipeds and quadrupeds abound; but such failure may 146 have arisen, not because the population of the land or sea was scanty at that era, but because in general the preservation of any relics of the animals or plants of former times is the exception to a general rule. Time so enormous as that contemplated by the geologist may multiply exceptional cases till they seem to constitute the rule, and so impose on the imagination as to lead us to infer the non-existence of creatures of which no monuments happen to remain. Professor Forbes has remarked, that few geologists are aware how large a proportion of all known species of fossils are founded on single specimens, while a still greater number are founded on a few individuals discovered in one spot. This holds true not only in regard to animals and plants inhabiting the land, the lake, and the river, but even to a surprising number of the marine mollusca, articulata, and radiata. Our knowledge, therefore, of the living creation of any given period of the past may be said to depend in a great degree on what we commonly call chance, and the casual discovery of some new localities rich in peculiar fossils may modify or entirely overthrow all our previous generalizations.

That mammals were created long before the time of the Kimmeridge clay is shown by the Microlestes from the Triassic period mentioned earlier, and by the quadrupeds found in Stonesfield from the Inferior Oolite. We must remember that whenever we conclude the lack of diversity in the flora or fauna of any past period based on the small number of fossils found in ancient rocks, it was clearly not Nature's intention to provide us with a complete or systematic record of the history of living things. We might not find a single shell, whether marine or freshwater, or any coral or bones in certain sandstones, like those in the Connecticut valley, where there are plenty of footprints from bipedal and quadrupedal animals. However, this absence may not mean that the population of land or sea was sparse at that time; rather, it highlights that the preservation of any remnants of past animals or plants is generally rare. The immense amount of time considered by geologists can make these rare cases appear to be the norm, tricking our imagination into thinking that creatures existed only where we find evidence. Professor Forbes has noted that few geologists realize how many known fossil species are based on single specimens, while a larger number rely on just a few individuals found in one location. This applies not only to land, lake, and river species but also to a surprisingly large number of marine mollusks, articulated animals, and radiates. Thus, our understanding of the living creations from any given past period largely depends on what we often call chance, and the occasional discovery of new sites rich in unique fossils can change or completely overturn our previous conclusions.

Upon the whole then we derive this result from a general review of the fossils of the successive tertiary strata, namely, that since the Eocene period, there have been several great changes in the land quadrupeds inhabiting Europe, probably not less than five complete revolutions, during which there has been no step whatever made in advance, no elevation in the scale of being; so that had man been created at the commencement of the Eocene era, he would not have constituted a greater innovation on the state of the animal creation previously established than now, when we believe him to have begun to exist at the close of the Pleiocene. The views, therefore, which I proposed in the first edition of this work, January, 1830, in opposition to the theory of progressive development, do not seem to me to require material modification, notwithstanding the large additions since made to our knowledge of fossil remains.

Overall, we conclude from a broad examination of the fossils in the different tertiary layers that since the Eocene period, there have been several significant changes in the land mammals living in Europe, likely at least five complete cycles, during which there has been no progress made, no advancement in the hierarchy of life; thus, if humans had been created at the start of the Eocene era, they would not have represented a greater shift in the state of the animal kingdom than now, when we think they began to exist at the end of the Pliocene. Therefore, the ideas I put forward in the first edition of this work, published in January 1830, opposing the theory of progressive development, still seem to me to require no major changes, despite the substantial contributions we've made to our understanding of fossil remains since then.

These views may be thus briefly stated. From the earliest period at which plants and animals can be proved to have existed, there has been a continual change going on in the position of land and sea, accompanied by great fluctuations of climate. To these ever-varying geographical and climatal conditions the state of the animate world has been unceasingly adapted. No satisfactory proof has yet been discovered of the gradual passage of the earth from a chaotic to a more habitable state, nor of any law of progressive development governing the extinction and renovation of species, and causing the fauna and flora to pass from an embryonic to a more perfect condition, from a simple to a more complex organization.

These views can be briefly summarized. Since the earliest time we can prove that plants and animals existed, there has been a constant change in the positions of land and sea, along with significant climate fluctuations. The state of the living world has continually adapted to these ever-changing geographical and climatic conditions. So far, no convincing evidence has been found for the gradual transition of the Earth from a chaotic state to a more livable one, nor for any law of progressive development that governs the extinction and renewal of species, leading the flora and fauna from a basic to a more advanced state, from simple to more complex structures.

The principle of adaptation to which I have alluded, appears to have been analogous to that which now peoples the arctic, temperate, and tropical regions contemporaneously with distinct assemblages of species and genera, or which, independently of mere temperature, gives rise to a predominance of the marsupial or didelphous tribe of quadrupeds in 147 Australia, of the placental or monodelphous tribe in Asia and Europe, or which causes a profusion of reptiles without mammalia in the Galapagos Archipelago, and of mammalia without reptiles in Greenland.

The adaptation principle I mentioned seems to be similar to what we see in the arctic, temperate, and tropical regions today, each with their own distinct groups of species and genera. This principle also explains why we find a dominance of marsupials in Australia, while placental mammals are prevalent in Asia and Europe, or why there are many reptiles but no mammals in the Galapagos Islands, and many mammals but no reptiles in Greenland.

Recent origin of man.—If, then, the popular theory of the successive development of the animal and vegetable world, from the simplest to the most perfect forms, rests on a very insecure foundation; it may be asked, whether the recent origin of man lends any support to the same doctrine, or how far the influence of man may be considered as such a deviation from the analogy of the order of things previously established, as to weaken our confidence in the uniformity of the course of nature.

Recent origin of man.—If the widely accepted theory of the progressive development of the animal and plant kingdoms, from the simplest to the most complex forms, is based on a shaky foundation, we might wonder whether the recent emergence of humans supports this same idea. Alternatively, how much might humanity's influence be seen as a departure from the established order of things, potentially undermining our trust in the consistency of natural processes?

Antecedently to investigation, we might reasonably have anticipated that the vestiges of man would have been traced back at least as far as those modern strata in which all the testacea and a certain number of the mammalia are of existing species, for of all the mammalia the human species is the most cosmopolite, and perhaps more capable than any other of surviving considerable vicissitudes in climate, and in the physical geography of the globe.

Before the investigation, we could have reasonably expected that traces of humans would be found at least as far back as the recent layers where all the shellfish and some of the mammals are of existing species. This is because, out of all mammals, humans are the most widespread and are perhaps better able than any other species to survive significant changes in climate and the physical geography of the Earth.

No inhabitant of the land exposes himself to so many dangers on the waters as man, whether in a savage or a civilized state;228 and there is no animal, therefore, whose skeleton is so liable to become imbedded in lacustrine or submarine deposits; nor can it be said that his remains are more perishable than those of other animals; for in ancient fields of battle, as Cuvier has observed, the bones of men have suffered as little decomposition as those of horses which were buried in the same grave.229 But even if the more solid parts of our species had disappeared, the impression of their form would have remained engraven on the rocks, as have the traces of the tenderest leaves of plants, and the soft integuments of many animals. Works of art, moreover, composed of the most indestructible materials, would have outlasted almost all the organic contents of sedimentary rocks. Edifices, and even entire cities, have, within the times of history, been buried under volcanic ejections, submerged beneath the sea, or engulfed by earthquakes; and had these catastrophes been repeated throughout an indefinite lapse of ages, the high antiquity of man would have been inscribed in far more legible characters on the framework of the globe than are the forms of the ancient vegetation which once covered the islands of the northern ocean, or of those gigantic reptiles which at still later periods peopled the seas and rivers of the northern hemisphere.230

No one in the land faces as many dangers on the water as humans do, whether in a wild or civilized state; 228 and no other animal's skeleton is as likely to get buried in lake or sea deposits. It can't be said that human remains are more likely to decompose than those of other animals; as Cuvier noted, the bones of humans have decayed just as little as the bones of horses that were buried in the same grave.229 Even if the harder parts of our species had vanished, the shape of our forms would still have been imprinted on the rocks, just like the delicate leaves of plants and the soft coverings of many animals. Moreover, works of art made from the most enduring materials would have outlasted almost all the organic matter found in sedimentary rocks. Buildings, and even entire cities, have been buried under volcanic eruptions, submerged beneath the ocean, or swallowed by earthquakes throughout history; and if these disasters had occurred repeatedly over an indefinite period, the ancient history of mankind would have been recorded in much clearer signs on the planet's surface than the patterns of the old vegetation that used to cover the northern ocean islands or the gigantic reptiles that later inhabited the seas and rivers of the northern hemisphere.230

Dr. Prichard has argued that the human race have not always existed on the surface of the earth, because "the strata of which our continents are composed were once a part of the ocean's bed"—"mankind had a beginning, since we can look back to the period when the surface on which they lived began to exist."231 This proof, however, is insufficient, 148 for many thousands of human beings now dwell in various quarters of the globe where marine species lived within the times of history, and, on the other hand, the sea now prevails permanently over large districts once inhabited by thousands of human beings. Nor can this interchange of sea and land ever cease while the present causes are in existence. Terrestrial species, therefore, might be older than the continents which they inhabit, and aquatic species of higher antiquity than the lakes and seas which they now people.

Dr. Prichard has argued that humanity hasn’t always existed on the surface of the Earth because "the layers that make up our continents were once part of the ocean floor"—"humans had a beginning, as we can trace back to the time when the land they lived on first emerged."231 However, this evidence is not enough, 148 since many thousands of people now live in different parts of the world where marine life existed during recorded history, and, on the flip side, the ocean now permanently covers large areas that were once home to thousands of people. Moreover, this back-and-forth between land and sea will continue as long as the current factors remain constant. Therefore, land species might be older than the continents they inhabit, and aquatic species could be even older than the lakes and seas they currently inhabit.

But so far as our interpretation of physical movements has yet gone, we have every reason to infer that the human race is extremely modern, even when compared to the larger number of species now our contemporaries on the earth, and we may, therefore, ask whether his creation can be considered as one step in a supposed progressive system, by which the organic world has advanced slowly from a more simple to a more complex and perfect state? If we concede, for a moment, the truth of the proposition, that the sponge, the cephalopod, the fish, the reptile, the bird, and the mammifer, have followed each other in regular chronological order, the creation of each class being separated from the other by vast intervals of time, should we be able to recognize, in man's entrance upon the earth, the last term of one and the same series of progressive developments?

But based on how we've understood physical movements so far, we have every reason to believe that humanity is quite modern, even when compared to many of the species that exist today. So, we can ask whether human creation can be seen as a step in a supposed progressive system, where the organic world has gradually evolved from simpler forms to more complex and perfected states. If we briefly accept the idea that sponges, cephalopods, fish, reptiles, birds, and mammals have appeared in a regular chronological order, with each class emerging after long intervals of time, could we view the arrival of humans on Earth as the final stage in this continuous series of progressive developments?

In reply to this question it should first be observed, that the superiority of man depends not on those faculties and attributes which he shares in common with the inferior animals, but on his reason, by which he is distinguished from them. When it is said that the human race is of far higher dignity than were any pre-existing beings on the earth, it is the intellectual and moral attributes of our race, rather than the physical, which are considered; and it is by no means clear that the organization of man is such as would confer a decided pre-eminence upon him, if, in place of his reasoning powers, he was merely provided with such instincts as are possessed by the lower animals.

In response to this question, it should be noted that human superiority doesn't come from the traits and abilities we share with lesser animals, but from our capacity for reason, which sets us apart. When we say that humanity is far more dignified than any beings that existed before on earth, we're talking about our intellectual and moral qualities, not our physical ones. It's also not entirely obvious that human organization gives us clear superiority, especially if we only had the instincts of lower animals instead of our reasoning abilities.

If this be admitted, it would not follow, even if there were sufficient geological evidence in favor of the theory of progressive development, that the creation of man was the last link in the same chain. For the sudden passage from an irrational to a rational animal, is a phenomenon of a distinct kind from the passage from the more simple to the more perfect forms of animal organization and instinct. To pretend that such a step, or rather leap, can be part of a regular series of changes in the animal world, is to strain analogy beyond all reasonable bounds.

If this is accepted, it wouldn't mean that, even if there was enough geological evidence supporting the theory of progressive development, the creation of man was the final link in that chain. The abrupt shift from an irrational animal to a rational one is a different kind of phenomenon compared to the transition from simpler to more advanced forms of animal organization and instinct. To suggest that such a step, or rather leap, could be part of a regular series of changes in the animal kingdom is to stretch the analogy beyond reasonable limits.

Introduction of man, to what extent a change in the system.—But setting aside the question of progressive development, another and a far more difficult one may arise out of the admission that man is comparatively of modern origin. Is not the interference of the human species, it may be asked, such a deviation from the antecedent course of physical events, that the knowledge of such a fact tends to destroy all our confidence in the uniformity of the order of nature, both in regard 149 to time past and future? If such an innovation could take place after the earth had been exclusively inhabited for thousands of ages by inferior animals, why should not other changes as extraordinary and unprecedented happen from time to time? If one new cause was permitted to supervene, differing in kind and energy from any before in operation, why may not others have come into action at different epochs? Or what security have we that they may not arise hereafter? And if such be the case, how can the experience of one period, even though we are acquainted with all the possible effects of the then existing causes, be a standard to which we can refer all natural phenomena of other periods?

Introduction of man, to what extent a change in the system.—But putting aside the question of gradual development, another, much tougher question arises from the acknowledgment that humans have a relatively recent origin. Doesn’t the emergence of our species represent such a break from the prior course of physical events that knowing this fact undermines our confidence in the consistency of nature's order, both in the past and the future? If such a change could happen after the earth was solely inhabited for thousands of years by lesser creatures, why shouldn't other extraordinary and unprecedented changes occur from time to time? If one new cause was allowed to emerge, vastly different in nature and strength from anything that came before, what’s to stop other forces from acting at various points in history? And how can we be sure they won’t arise in the future? If that’s the case, how can the experiences of one time period, no matter how well we understand the potential effects of existing causes then, serve as a reliable reference for understanding natural phenomena in other times?

Now these objections would be unanswerable, if adduced against one who was contending for the absolute uniformity throughout all time of the succession of sublunary events—if, for example, he was disposed to indulge in the philosophical reveries of some Egyptian and Greek sects, who represented all the changes both of the moral and material world as repeated at distant intervals, so as to follow each other in their former connection of place and time. For they compared the course of events on our globe to astronomical cycles; and not only did they consider all sublunary affairs to be under the influence of the celestial bodies, but they taught that on the earth, as well as in the heavens, the same identical phenomena recurred again and again in a perpetual vicissitude. The same individual men were doomed to be re-born, and to perform the same actions as before; the same arts were to be invented, and the same cities built and destroyed. The Argonautic expedition was destined to sail again with the same heroes, and Achilles with his Myrmidons to renew, the combat before the walls of Troy.

Now, these objections would be hard to refute if directed at someone arguing for the absolute uniformity of sublunary events throughout time—like, for instance, if they were caught up in the philosophical musings of certain Egyptian and Greek sects that believed all changes, both moral and material, repeated at long intervals, following the same connections of time and place. They likened the course of events on our planet to astronomical cycles; not only did they think that all earthly matters were influenced by celestial bodies, but they also taught that the same identical phenomena repeated themselves over and over in a never-ending cycle. Individual people were destined to be reborn and perform the same actions as before; the same arts would be invented, and the same cities would be built and destroyed. The Argonauts were meant to set sail again with the same heroes, and Achilles with his Myrmidons was destined to fight once more before the walls of Troy.

Alter erit tum Tiphys, et altera quæ vehat Argo Dilectos heroas; erunt etiam altera bella, Atque iterum ad Trojam magnus mittetur Achilles.232

Alter will then be Tiphys, and another will carry the Argo with beloved heroes; there will also be another war, and once more, mighty Achilles will be sent to Troy.232

The geologist, however, may condemn these tenets as absurd, without running into the opposite extreme, and denying that the order of nature has, from the earliest periods, been uniform in the same sense in which we believe it to be uniform at present, and expect it to remain so in future. We have no reason to suppose, that when man first became master of a small part of the globe, a greater change took place in its physical condition than is now experienced when districts, never before inhabited, become successively occupied by new settlers. When a powerful European colony lands on the shores of Australia, and introduces at once those arts which it has required many centuries to mature; when it imports a multitude of plants and large animals from the opposite extremity of the earth, and begins rapidly to extirpate many of the indigenous species, a mightier revolution is effected in a brief period than the first entrance of a savage horde, or their continued occupation 150 of the country for many centuries, can possibly be imagined to have produced. If there be no impropriety in assuming that the system is uniform when disturbances so unprecedented occur in certain localities, we can with much greater confidence apply the same language to those primeval ages when the aggregate number and power of the human race, or the rate of their advancement in civilization, must be supposed to have been far inferior. In reasoning on the state of the globe immediately before our species was called into existence, we must be guided by the same rules of induction as when we speculate on the state of America in the interval that elapsed between the introduction of man into Asia, the supposed cradle of our race, and the arrival of the first adventurers on the shores of the New World. In that interval, we imagine the state of things to have gone on according to the order now observed in regions unoccupied by man. Even now, the waters of lakes, seas, and the great ocean, which teem with life, may be said to have no immediate relation to the human race—to be portions of the terrestrial system of which man has never taken, nor ever can take possession; so that the greater part of the inhabited surface of the planet may still remain as insensible to our presence as before any isle or continent was appointed to be our residence.

The geologist might consider these beliefs ridiculous, but they won't go to the other extreme of saying that nature's order has been consistent since the beginning in the same way we believe it is today and expect it to continue in the future. We have no reason to think that when humans first took control of a small part of the Earth, it caused a bigger change in its physical state than what happens now when areas that were previously uninhabited are gradually settled by newcomers. When a strong European colony lands on the shores of Australia and immediately brings along skills that took centuries to develop; when it brings in many plants and large animals from the other side of the planet and quickly starts to wipe out many native species, a more significant change occurs in a short time than that which could possibly have been caused by the initial arrival of a primitive group or their prolonged stay in the area for many centuries. If it’s reasonable to assume that the system remains uniform even when such unprecedented disruptions happen in specific locations, we can be even more confident in using the same reasoning for those ancient times when the total number and capability of humans, or the speed of their advancement in civilization, must have been much less. When thinking about the state of the Earth just before humans came into being, we should follow the same principles of deduction as when we consider the state of America during the time between the arrival of humans in Asia, the supposed origin of our species, and the landing of the first explorers in the New World. In that time, we envision things continuing as they do now in areas not occupied by humans. Even today, the waters of lakes, seas, and the vast ocean, which are full of life, can be said to have no direct connection to humans—they are parts of the Earth's system that humanity has never owned, nor ever will; thus, much of the land on the planet can still be as oblivious to our existence as it was before any island or continent was designated as our home.

If the barren soil around Sydney had at once become fertile upon the landing of our first settlers; if, like the happy isles whereof the poets have given such glowing descriptions, those sandy tracts had begun to yield spontaneously an annual supply of grain, we might then, indeed, have fancied alterations still more remarkable in the economy of nature to have attended the first coming of our species into the planet. Or if, when a volcanic island like Ischia was, for the first time, brought under cultivation by the enterprise and industry of a Greek colony, the internal fire had become dormant, and the earthquake had remitted its destructive violence, there would then have been some ground for speculating on the debilitation of the subterranean forces, when the earth was first placed under the dominion of man. But after a long interval of rest, the volcano bursts forth again with renewed energy, annihilates one half of the inhabitants, and compels the remainder to emigrate. The course of nature remains evidently unchanged; and, in like manner, we may suppose the general condition of the globe, immediately before and after the period when our species first began to exist, to have been the same, with the exception only of man's presence.

If the barren soil around Sydney had immediately become fertile when our first settlers arrived; if, like the happy islands that poets have described so vividly, those sandy areas began to produce an annual supply of grain on their own, we might have thought that even more remarkable changes in nature accompanied the arrival of our species on the planet. Or if, when a volcanic island like Ischia was first farmed by a Greek colony, the internal fire had gone quiet and the earthquakes had stopped their destructive force, there would be some reason to speculate about a weakening of the underground forces when the earth was first put under human control. But after a long period of dormancy, the volcano erupts again with new strength, destroys half of the population, and forces the rest to leave. The course of nature clearly remains unchanged; similarly, we can assume that the general state of the globe, just before and after our species first appeared, was the same, except for the presence of humans.

The modifications in the system of which man is the instrument do not, perhaps, constitute so great a deviation from previous analogy as we usually imagine; we often, for example, form an exaggerated estimate of the extent of our power in extirpating some of the inferior animals, and causing others to multiply; a power which is circumscribed within certain limits, and which, in all likelihood, is by no means exclusively exerted by our species.233 The growth of human population cannot 151 take place without diminishing the numbers, or causing the entire destruction, of many animals. The larger beasts of prey, in particular, give way before us; but other quadrupeds of smaller size, and innumerable birds, insects, and plants, which are inimical to our interests, increase in spite of us, some attacking our food, others our raiment and persons, and others interfering with our agricultural and horticultural labors. We behold the rich harvest which we have raised by the sweat of our brow, devoured by myriads of insects, and are often as incapable of arresting their depredations, as of staying the shock of an earthquake, or the course of a stream of lava.

The changes in the system where humans play a role might not be as big of a departure from previous patterns as we often think. For example, we tend to overestimate our ability to eliminate certain weaker animals and make others thrive; our power is limited and likely not solely exercised by our species. 233 The growth of the human population cannot occur without reducing the numbers or completely wiping out many animal species. The larger predators, in particular, are pushed out by us, but many smaller mammals, countless birds, insects, and plants that are harmful to us continue to thrive, some attacking our food, others damaging our clothing and posing threats to our agricultural and horticultural efforts. We see the abundant crops we've cultivated through hard work being devoured by swarms of insects, and we often find ourselves as powerless to stop their destruction as we would be to halt an earthquake or redirect a flow of lava.

A great philosopher has observed, that we can command nature only by obeying her laws; and this principle is true even in regard to the astonishing changes which are superinduced in the qualities of certain animals and plants by domestication and garden culture. I shall point out in the third book that we can only effect such surprising alterations by assisting the development of certain instincts, or by availing ourselves of that mysterious law of their organization, by which individual peculiarities are transmissible from one generation to another.234

A great philosopher noted that we can control nature only by following her laws; this principle holds true even regarding the remarkable changes that occur in the qualities of certain animals and plants due to domestication and gardening. In the third book, I will explain that we can only achieve such surprising changes by supporting the development of specific instincts or by using the mysterious law of their organization, which allows individual traits to be passed down from one generation to the next.234

It is probable from these and many other considerations, that as we enlarge our knowledge of the system, we shall become more and more convinced, that the alterations caused by the interference of man deviate far less from the analogy of those effected by other animals than is usually supposed.235 We are often misled, when we institute such comparisons, by our knowledge of the wide distinction between the instincts of animals and the reasoning power of man; and we are apt hastily to infer, that the effects of a rational and irrational species, considered merely as physical agents, will differ almost as much as the faculties by which their actions are directed.

It’s likely that from these and many other factors, as we expand our understanding of the system, we will become increasingly convinced that the changes brought about by human interference differ far less from those caused by other animals than we usually think. 235 We often get confused when we make such comparisons because we know there’s a significant difference between animal instincts and human reasoning; we tend to quickly assume that the impacts of rational and irrational species, when viewed simply as physical agents, will differ almost as much as the abilities that guide their actions.

It is not, however, intended that a real departure from the antecedent course of physical events cannot be traced in the introduction of man. If that latitude of action which enables the brutes to accommodate themselves in some measure to accidental circumstances could be imagined to have been at any former period so great, that the operations of instinct were as much diversified as are those of human reason, it might, perhaps, be contended, that the agency of man did not constitute an anomalous deviation from the previously established order of things. It might then have been said, that the earth's becoming at a particular period the residence of human beings, was an era in the moral, not in the physical world—that our study and contemplation of the earth, and the laws which govern its animate productions, ought no more to be considered in the light of a disturbance or deviation from the system, than the discovery of the satellites of Jupiter should be regarded as a physical event affecting those heavenly bodies. Their influence in advancing the progress of science among men, and in aiding navigation and commerce, was accompanied by no reciprocal action 152 of the human mind upon the economy of nature in those distant planets; and so the earth might be conceived to have become, at a certain period, a place of moral discipline and intellectual improvement to man, without the slightest derangement of a previously existing order of change in its animate and inanimate productions.

It is not meant to say that a real break from the previous course of physical events can’t be seen with the introduction of humans. If we could imagine that the capacity for action which allows animals to adapt somewhat to random circumstances was, at some earlier time, so vast that instinctive behaviors were as varied as human reasoning, one might argue that human agency doesn’t represent a weird shift from the established order of things. It could then be claimed that the earth becoming a home for humans at a specific time was a turning point in the moral, not the physical world—that our study and understanding of the earth and the laws that govern its living beings should not be seen as a disruption or deviation from the system, any more than the discovery of Jupiter's moons should be considered as a physical event impacting those celestial bodies. Their role in advancing scientific knowledge among humans and in supporting navigation and trade came with no reciprocal effect of the human mind on the workings of nature in those far-off planets; thus, one might think of the earth as having become, at a certain time, a place for moral training and intellectual development for humans, without causing any disturbance to a previously existing order of change in its living and non-living entities.

The distinctness, however, of the human from all other species, considered merely as an efficient cause in the physical world, is real; for we stand in a relation to contemporary species of animals and plants widely different from that which other irrational animals can ever be supposed to have held to each other. We modify their instincts, relative numbers, and geographical distribution, in a manner superior in degree, and in some respects very different in kind from that in which any other species can affect the rest. Besides, the progressive movement of each successive generation of men causes the human species to differ more from itself in power at two distant periods, than any one species of the higher order of animals differs from another. The establishment, therefore, by geological evidence, of the first intervention of such a peculiar and unprecedented agency, long after other parts of the animate and inanimate world existed, affords ground for concluding that the experience during thousands of ages of all the events which may happen on this globe, would not enable a philosopher to speculate with confidence concerning future contingencies.

The uniqueness of humans compared to all other species, when viewed simply as an effective factor in the physical world, is clear; we have a relationship with current animal and plant species that is fundamentally different from the relationships that other non-human animals have with each other. We influence their instincts, populations, and geographic distribution in a way that is not only greater in degree but also different in kind from how any other species can impact the rest. Furthermore, the ongoing development of each generation of humans makes the species evolve more significantly over time compared to how different higher-order animal species are from one another. Therefore, the geological evidence of the earliest emergence of such a unique and unprecedented force, long after other living and non-living things had already existed, suggests that the experiences gained over thousands of years would not allow a philosopher to confidently predict future events happening on this planet.

If, then, an intelligent being, after observing the order of events for an indefinite series of ages, had witnessed at last so wonderful an innovation as this, to what extent would his belief in the regularity of the system be weakened?—would he cease to assume that there was permanency in the laws of nature?—would he no longer be guided in his speculations by the strictest rules of induction? To these questions it may be answered, that, had he previously presumed to dogmatize respecting the absolute uniformity of the order of nature, he would undoubtedly be checked by witnessing this new and unexpected event, and would form a more just estimate of the limited range of his own knowledge, and the unbounded extent of the scheme of the universe. But he would soon perceive that no one of the fixed and constant laws of the animate or inanimate world was subverted by human agency, and that the modifications now introduced for the first time were the accompaniments of new and extraordinary circumstances, and those not of a physical but a moral nature. The deviation permitted would also appear to be as slight as was consistent with the accomplishment of the new moral ends proposed, and to be in a great degree temporary in its nature, so that, whenever the power of the new agent was withheld, even for a brief period, a relapse would take place to the ancient state of things; the domesticated animal, for example, recovering in a few generations its wild instinct, and the garden-flower and fruit-tree reverting to the likeness of the parent stock.

If an intelligent being had watched the order of events for an indefinite period and finally saw such a remarkable change, how much would their belief in the regularity of the system be shaken? Would they stop believing that the laws of nature are permanent? Would they no longer rely on strict rules of induction in their thinking? In response to these questions, it can be said that if they had previously assumed the absolute uniformity of nature's order, witnessing this new and unexpected event would undoubtedly challenge that view. They would gain a better understanding of the limits of their own knowledge and the vastness of the universe's design. However, they would soon realize that none of the fixed and constant laws of living or non-living things were upended by human actions, and that the changes introduced for the first time were tied to new and extraordinary circumstances of a moral nature, not a physical one. The allowed deviation would also seem minor enough to achieve the new moral goals intended and would largely be temporary in nature; thus, whenever the influence of the new agent was removed, even briefly, a return to the old state would occur—like a domesticated animal regaining its wild instincts in a few generations, or a garden flower and fruit tree reverting to the characteristics of their wild ancestors.

Now, if it would be reasonable to draw such inferences with respect to the future, we cannot but apply the same rules of induction to the 153 past. We have no right to anticipate any modifications in the results of existing causes in time to come, which are not conformable to analogy, unless they be produced by the progressive development of human power, or perhaps by some other new relations which may hereafter spring up between the moral and material worlds. In the same manner, when we speculate on the vicissitudes of the animate and inanimate creation in former ages, we ought not to look for any anomalous results, unless where man has interfered, or unless clear indications appear of some other moral source of temporary derangement.

Now, if it's reasonable to make such inferences about the future, we must apply the same rules of induction to the past. We have no right to expect any changes in the outcomes of existing causes in the future that don't align with what we've seen before, unless they're caused by the ongoing development of human ability, or possibly by new connections that may emerge between the moral and material worlds. Similarly, when we think about the changes in living and non-living things in the past, we shouldn't expect any unusual outcomes unless humans have interfered, or unless there are clear signs of some other moral source causing temporary disruptions.


CHAPTER X.

SUPPOSED INTENSITY OF AQUEOUS FORCES AT REMOTE PERIODS.

Intensity of aqueous causes—Slow accumulation of strata proved by fossils—Rate of denudation can only keep pace with deposition—Erratics, and effects of ice—Deluges, and the causes to which they are referred—Supposed universality of ancient deposits.

Intensity of water-related processes—Slow buildup of layers confirmed by fossils—The rate of erosion can only match the rate of sediment deposition—Erratics and the impact of ice—Floods, and the reasons attributed to them—The assumed widespread nature of ancient deposits.

Intensity of aqueous causes.—The great problem considered in the preceding chapters, namely, whether the former changes of the earth made known to us by geology, resemble in kind and degree those now in daily progress, may still be contemplated from several other points of view. We may inquire, for example, whether there are any grounds for the belief entertained by many, that the intensity both of aqueous and of igneous forces, in remote ages, far exceeded that which we witness in our own times.

Intensity of aqueous causes.—The major issue discussed in the previous chapters, which is whether the past changes of the earth revealed by geology are similar in kind and degree to those occurring today, can still be examined from various perspectives. We can ask, for instance, if there is any basis for the belief held by many that the intensity of both water-related and volcanic forces in ancient times was significantly greater than what we observe in our own era.

First, then, as to aqueous causes: it has been shown, in our history of the science, that Woodward did not hesitate, in 1695, to teach that the entire mass of fossiliferous strata contained in the earth's crust had been deposited in a few months; and, consequently, as their mechanical and derivative origin was already admitted, the reduction of rocky masses into mud, sand, and pebbles, the transportation of the same to a distance, and their accumulation elsewhere in regular strata, were all assumed to have taken place with a rapidity unparalleled in modern times. This doctrine was modified by degrees, in proportion as different classes of organic remains, such as shells, corals, and fossil plants, had been studied with attention. Analogy led every naturalist to assume, that each full-grown individual of the animal or vegetable kingdom, had required a certain number of months or years for the attainment of maturity, and the perpetuation of its species by generation; and thus the 154 first approach was made to the conception of a common standard of time, without which there are no means whatever of measuring the comparative rate at which any succession of events has taken place at two distinct periods. This standard consisted of the average duration of the lives of individuals of the same genera or families in the animal and vegetable kingdoms; and the multitude of fossils dispersed through successive strata implied the continuance of the same species for many generations. At length the idea that species themselves had had a limited duration, arose out of the observed fact that sets of strata of different ages contained fossils of distinct species. Finally, the opinion became general, that in the course of ages, one assemblage of animals and plants had disappeared after another again and again, and new tribes had started into life to replace them.

First, regarding water-related causes: it's been established in our science history that Woodward boldly claimed in 1695 that the entire mass of fossil-bearing layers in the earth's crust was deposited in just a few months. Consequently, since their mechanical and derived origins were accepted, the transformation of solid rock into mud, sand, and pebbles, the transport of these materials over distances, and their accumulation in distinct layers were all thought to have occurred with an unprecedented speed. This theory gradually evolved as various types of organic remains, like shells, corals, and fossil plants, were carefully studied. Analogy led every naturalist to assume that each mature individual in the animal or plant kingdom required a certain number of months or years to grow and to reproduce its species. Thus, the first attempt was made to establish a common time standard, without which it's impossible to measure the relative speed at which events occurred over two different periods. This standard was based on the average lifespan of individuals within the same genera or families in both the animal and plant kingdoms; the abundance of fossils found across successive layers indicated the persistence of the same species over many generations. Eventually, the notion that species themselves had a limited lifespan emerged from the observation that sets of layers from different periods contained fossils of different species. Ultimately, it became a common belief that over time, one group of animals and plants would disappear repeatedly, and new groups would arise to take their place.

Denudation.—In addition to the proofs derived from organic remains, the forms of stratification led also, on a fuller investigation, to the belief that sedimentary rocks had been slowly deposited; but it was still supposed that denudation, or the power of running water, and the waves and currents of the ocean, to strip off superior strata, and lay bare the rocks below, had formerly operated with an energy wholly unequalled in our times. These opinions were both illogical and inconsistent, because deposition and denudation are parts of the same process, and what is true of the one must be true of the other. Their speed must be always limited by the same causes, and the conveyance of solid matter to a particular region can only keep pace with its removal from another, so that the aggregate of sedimentary strata in the earth's crust can never exceed in volume the amount of solid matter which has been ground down and washed away by running water. How vast, then, must be the spaces which this abstraction of matter has left vacant! how far exceeding in dimensions all the valleys, however numerous, and the hollows, however vast, which we can prove to have been cleared out by aqueous erosion! The evidences of the work of denudation are defective, because it is the nature of every destroying cause to obliterate the signs of its own agency; but the amount of reproduction in the form of sedimentary strata must always afford a true measure of the minimum of denudation which the earth's surface has undergone.

Denudation.—Besides the evidence from organic remains, the patterns of layering also led to the conclusion, upon deeper investigation, that sedimentary rocks were slowly formed over time. However, it was still believed that denudation, or the ability of flowing water, along with ocean waves and currents, to remove top layers of sediment and expose the underlying rocks, operated with a power that was completely unmatched in our current era. These views were both illogical and contradictory, as deposition and denudation are parts of the same process, and what applies to one must apply to the other. Their rates must always be constrained by the same factors, and the movement of solid material to a specific area can only match its removal from another area. Therefore, the total volume of sedimentary layers in the earth's crust can never exceed the amount of solid material that has been eroded and carried away by flowing water. How enormous must be the spaces left empty by this removal of material! They certainly surpass in size all the valleys, no matter how many, and the depressions, regardless of how large, that we can demonstrate have been formed by water erosion! The evidence of denudation's impacts is limited because the nature of any destructive force tends to erase the signs of its own activity. However, the volume of sedimentary strata created must always provide a reliable gauge of the minimum level of denudation that the earth's surface has experienced.

Erratics.—The next phenomenon to which the advocates of the excessive power of running water in times past have appealed, is the enormous size of the blocks called erratic, which lie scattered over the northern parts of Europe and North America. Unquestionably a large proportion of these blocks have been transported far from their original position, for between them and the parent rocks we now find, not unfrequently, deep seas and valleys intervening, or hills more than a thousand feet high. To explain the present situation of such travelled fragments, a deluge of mud has been imagined by some to have come from the north, bearing along with it sand, gravel, and stony fragments, some of them hundreds of tons in weight. This flood, in its transient passage over the continents, dispersed the boulders irregularly over hill, valley, 155 and plain; or forced them along over a surface of hard rock, so as to polish it and leave it indented with parallel scratches and grooves—such markings as are still visible in the rocks of Scandinavia, Scotland, Canada, and many other countries.

Erratics.—The next phenomenon that supporters of the extreme power of running water in the past have cited is the massive blocks known as erratic, which are scattered across the northern areas of Europe and North America. It's clear that a significant number of these blocks have been moved far from their original locations, as between them and the parent rocks, we often find deep seas and valleys, or hills that are over a thousand feet tall. To explain the current placement of these displaced fragments, some have suggested that a flood of mud came from the north, carrying sand, gravel, and stony fragments, some weighing hundreds of tons. This flood, during its brief journey across the continents, spread the boulders unevenly over hills, valleys, and plains; or dragged them over hard rock surfaces, polishing them and leaving behind parallel scratches and grooves—markings that can still be seen in the rocks of Scandinavia, Scotland, Canada, and various other nations.

There can be no doubt that the myriads of angular and rounded blocks above alluded to, cannot have been borne along by ordinary rivers or marine currents, so great is their volume and weight, and so clear are the signs, in many places, of time having been occupied in their successive deposition; for they are often distributed at various depths through heaps of regularly stratified sand and gravel. No waves of the sea raised by earthquakes, nor the bursting of lakes dammed up for a time by landslips or by avalanches of snow, can account for the observed facts; but I shall endeavor to show, in the next book, chap. 15,236 that a combination of existing causes may have conveyed erratics into their present situations.

There’s no question that the countless angular and rounded blocks mentioned earlier couldn’t have been moved by regular rivers or ocean currents, given their massive size and weight. There are clear indications in many places that a lot of time was spent depositing them in layers; they’re often found at different depths among piles of neatly layered sand and gravel. No sea waves caused by earthquakes, nor lakes that overflowed due to landslides or snow avalanches, can explain what we see. However, I will try to demonstrate in the next book, chap. 15,236 that a combination of current factors may have transported these erratics to their current locations.

The causes which will be referred to are, first, the carrying power of ice, combined with that of running water; and second, the upward movement of the bed of the sea, converting it gradually into land. Without entering at present into any details respecting these causes, I may mention that the transportation of blocks by ice is now simultaneously in progress in the cold and temperate latitudes, both of the northern and southern hemisphere, as, for example, on the coasts of Canada and Gulf of St. Lawrence, and also in Chili, Patagonia, and the island of South Georgia. In those regions the uneven bed of the ocean is becoming strewed over with ice-drifted fragments, which have either stranded on shoals, or been dropped in deep water by melting bergs. The entanglement of boulders in drift-ice will also be shown to occur annually in North America, and these stones, when firmly frozen into ice, wander year after year from Labrador to the St. Lawrence, and reach points of the western hemisphere farther south than any part of Great Britain.

The causes I'll discuss are, first, the ability of ice to carry objects, combined with the power of flowing water; and second, the gradual upward movement of the sea floor that is turning it into land. Without diving into the details of these causes just yet, I should point out that the movement of blocks by ice is currently happening in both cold and temperate regions of the northern and southern hemispheres. For example, this is occurring along the coasts of Canada and the Gulf of St. Lawrence, as well as in Chile, Patagonia, and South Georgia. In those areas, the uneven ocean floor is becoming covered with fragments carried by ice, which have either become stuck on shallow areas or have been dropped into deeper waters by melting icebergs. The mixing of boulders in drift ice is also seen annually in North America, where these stones, once frozen into the ice, move year after year from Labrador to the St. Lawrence, reaching points in the western hemisphere farther south than any part of Great Britain.

The general absence of erratics in the warmer parts of the equatorial regions of Asia, Africa, and America, confirms the same views. As to the polishing and grooving of hard rocks, it has lately been ascertained that glaciers give rise to these effects when pushing forward sand, pebbles, and rocky fragments, and causing them to grate along the bottom. Nor can there be any reasonable doubt that icebergs, when they run aground on the floor of the ocean, must imprint similar marks upon it.

The general lack of erratics in the warmer parts of the equatorial regions of Asia, Africa, and America supports the same ideas. Recently, it has been determined that glaciers cause the polishing and grooving of hard rocks by pushing forward sand, pebbles, and rock fragments, which then scrape along the ground. It’s also reasonable to believe that icebergs, when they ground on the ocean floor, would leave similar marks.

It is unnecessary, therefore, to refer to deluges, or even to speculate on the former existence of a climate more severe than that now prevailing in the western hemisphere, to explain the geographical distribution of most of the European erratics.

It’s not necessary, then, to talk about floods or even to guess about a time when the climate was harsher than it is now in the western hemisphere to explain where most of the European erratics are found.

Deluges.—As deluges have been often alluded to, I shall say something of the causes which may be supposed to give rise to these grand movements of water in addition to those already alluded to (p. 9). Geologists who believe that mountain-chains have been thrown up suddenly 156 at many successive epochs, imagine that the waters of the ocean may be raised by these convulsions, and then break in terrific waves upon the land, sweeping over whole continents, hollowing out valleys, and transporting sand, gravel, and erratics, to great distances. The sudden rise of the Alps or Andes, it is said, may have produced a flood even subsequently to the time when the earth became the residence of man. But it seems strange that none of the writers who have indulged their imaginations in conjectures of this kind, should have ascribed a deluge to the sudden conversion of part of the unfathomable ocean into a shoal rather than to the rise of mountain-chains. In the latter case, the mountains themselves could do no more than displace a certain quantity of atmospheric air, whereas, the instantaneous formation of the shoal would displace a vast body of water, which being heaved up to a great height might roll over and permanently submerge a large portion of a continent.

Deluges.—Since deluges have been frequently mentioned, I’ll discuss some of the causes that might lead to these massive movements of water beyond those already noted (p. 9). Geologists who think that mountain ranges have been suddenly raised at various times believe that these geological events could cause ocean waters to rise, crashing onto the land in massive waves that wash over entire continents, carve out valleys, and carry sand, gravel, and debris great distances. It’s suggested that the sudden uplift of the Alps or Andes could have resulted in a flood even after humans began inhabiting the Earth. However, it’s odd that none of the authors who have speculated on this topic have attributed a deluge to the quick transformation of part of the deep ocean into a shallow area instead of the uplift of mountain ranges. In the latter scenario, the mountains would only displace a limited amount of air, while the sudden creation of a shoal would displace a significant volume of water, which, when pushed up to a high point, could spill over and permanently flood a large section of a continent.

If we restrict ourselves to combinations of causes at present known, it would seem that the two principal sources of extraordinary inundations are, first, the escape of the waters of a large lake raised far above the sea; and, secondly, the pouring down of a marine current into lands depressed below the mean level of the ocean.

If we limit ourselves to combinations of causes that are currently understood, it appears that the two main sources of massive floods are, first, the release of water from a large lake situated high above sea level; and, second, the inflow of ocean currents into areas that are lower than the average elevation of the ocean.

As an example of the first of these cases, we may take Lake Superior, which is more than 400 geographical miles in length and about 150 in breadth, having an average depth of from 500 to 900 feet. The surface of this vast body of fresh water is no less than 600 feet above the level of the ocean; the lowest part of the barrier which separates the lake on its southwest side from those streams which flow into the head waters of the Mississippi being about 600 feet high. If, therefore, a series of subsidences should lower any part of this barrier 600 feet, any subsequent rending or depression, even of a few yards at a time, would allow the sudden escape of vast floods of water into a hydrographical basin of enormous extent. If the event happened in the dry season, when the ordinary channels of the Mississippi and its tributaries are in a great degree empty, the inundation might not be considerable; but if in the flood-season, a region capable of supporting a population of many millions might be suddenly submerged. But even this event would be insufficient to cause a violent rush of water, and to produce those effects usually called diluvial; for the difference of level of 600 feet between Lake Superior and the Gulf of Mexico, when distributed over a distance of 1800 miles, would give an average fall of only four inches per mile.

As an example of the first case, we can look at Lake Superior, which is over 400 miles long and about 150 miles wide, with an average depth of between 500 and 900 feet. The surface of this huge body of fresh water sits more than 600 feet above sea level; the lowest point of the barrier that separates the lake from the rivers flowing into the upper Mississippi is about 600 feet high. Therefore, if a series of sinkings were to lower any part of this barrier by 600 feet, any subsequent shifts or depressions, even just a few yards at a time, could lead to the sudden release of massive amounts of water into a very large drainage area. If this occurred during the dry season when the usual channels of the Mississippi and its tributaries are mostly empty, the flooding might not be severe. However, if it happened during the flood season, an area capable of supporting millions of people could be suddenly submerged. But even this scenario wouldn’t be enough to create a violent rush of water or cause what is typically called a flood disaster; the 600-foot elevation difference between Lake Superior and the Gulf of Mexico, when spread over 1,800 miles, would result in an average drop of only four inches per mile.

The second case before adverted to is where there are large tracts of dry land beneath the mean level of the ocean. It seems, after much controversy, to be at length a settled point, that the Caspian is really 83 feet 6 inches lower than the Black Sea. As the Caspian covers an area about equal to that of Spain, and as its shores are in general low and flat, there must be many thousand square miles of country less than 83 feet above the level of that inland sea, and consequently depressed below the Black Sea and Mediterranean. This area includes the site of 157 the populous city of Astrakhan and other towns. Into this region the ocean would pour its waters, if the land now intervening between the Sea of Azof and the Caspian should subside. Yet even if this event should occur, it is most probable that the submergence of the whole region would not be accomplished simultaneously, but by a series of minor floods, the sinking of the barrier being gradual.237

The second case mentioned earlier involves large areas of dry land that are below the average ocean level. After a lot of debate, it's now generally accepted that the Caspian Sea is actually 83 feet 6 inches lower than the Black Sea. Since the Caspian Sea is roughly the size of Spain and has mostly low, flat shores, there must be many thousands of square miles of land that are less than 83 feet above the level of that inland sea, and thus lower than both the Black Sea and the Mediterranean. This area includes the location of the bustling city of Astrakhan and other towns. If the land currently between the Sea of Azov and the Caspian Sea were to sink, the ocean would flow into this area. However, even if that were to happen, it’s quite likely that the flooding of the entire region wouldn’t happen all at once, but rather through a series of smaller floods, with the sinking of the land occurring gradually.157237

Supposed universality of ancient deposits.—The next fallacy which has helped to perpetuate the doctrine that the operations of water were on a different and grander scale in ancient times, is founded on the indefinite areas over which homogeneous deposits were supposed to extend. No modern sedimentary strata, it is said, equally identical in mineral character and fossil contents, can be traced continuously from one quarter of the globe to another. But the first propagators of these opinions were very slightly acquainted with the inconstancy in mineral composition of the ancient formations, and equally so of the wide spaces over which the same kind of sediment is now actually distributed by rivers and currents in the course of centuries. The persistency of character in the older series was exaggerated, its extreme variability in the newer was assumed without proof. In the chapter which treats of river-deltas and the dispersion of sediment by currents, and in the description of reefs of coral now growing over areas many hundred miles in length, I shall have opportunities of convincing the reader of the danger of hasty generalizations on this head.

Supposed universality of ancient deposits.—The next misconception that has contributed to the belief that water processes were more extensive and grand in ancient times is based on the undefined areas where uniform deposits were thought to exist. It is claimed that no modern sedimentary layers, equally similar in mineral makeup and fossil content, can be traced continuously across the globe. However, the early advocates of these views had only a limited understanding of the variability in mineral composition of ancient formations, as well as the extensive areas where similar types of sediment are currently distributed by rivers and currents over time. The consistency of characteristics in older layers was overstated, while the extreme variability in newer layers was assumed without evidence. In the chapter discussing river deltas and the spreading of sediment by currents, as well as in the description of coral reefs currently growing over areas spanning hundreds of miles, I will have opportunities to demonstrate to the reader the risks of making quick generalizations on this topic.

In regard to the imagined universality of particular rocks of ancient date, it was almost unavoidable that this notion, when once embraced, should be perpetuated; for the same kinds of rock have occasionally been reproduced at successive epochs; and when once the agreement or disagreement in mineral character alone was relied on as the test of age, it followed that similar rocks, if found even at the antipodes, were referred to the same era, until the contrary could be shown.

In relation to the assumed universality of certain ancient rocks, it was almost inevitable that this idea, once accepted, would continue; because the same types of rocks have sometimes appeared across different time periods. When the consistency or inconsistency in mineral composition was solely used as the measure of age, it meant that similar rocks, even if located at opposite ends of the world, were assigned to the same time period until evidence showed otherwise.

158 Now it is usually impossible to combat such an assumption on geological grounds, so long as we are imperfectly acquainted with the order of superposition and the organic remains of these same formations. Thus, for example, a group of red marl and red sandstone, containing salt and gypsum, being interposed in England between the Lias and the Coal, all other red marls and sandstones, associated some of them with salt, and others with gypsum, and occurring not only in different parts of Europe, but in North America, Peru, India, the salt deserts of Asia, those of Africa—in a word, in every quarter of the globe, were referred to one and the same period. The burden of proof was not supposed to rest with those who insisted on the identity in age of all these groups—their identity in mineral composition was thought sufficient. It was in vain to urge as an objection the improbability of the hypothesis which implies that all the moving waters on the globe were once simultaneously charged with sediment of a red color.

158 Now it's usually impossible to challenge such an assumption based on geological evidence, especially since we don't fully understand the order of superposition and the organic remains of these formations. For instance, a group of red marl and red sandstone that contains salt and gypsum, found in England between the Lias and the Coal, is linked to all other red marls and sandstones, some associated with salt and others with gypsum, found not just in different parts of Europe, but also in North America, Peru, India, the salt deserts of Asia, and Africa—essentially, everywhere on the globe, were thought to belong to the same time period. The responsibility to prove otherwise wasn’t expected from those who argued for the age similarity of all these groups—their similarity in mineral composition was considered enough. It was pointless to point out the unlikelihood of the theory suggesting that all the world's moving waters were once simultaneously carrying red-colored sediment.

But the rashness of pretending to identify, in age, all the red sandstones and marls in question, has at length been sufficiently exposed, by the discovery that, even in Europe, they belong decidedly to many different epochs. It is already ascertained, that the red sandstone and red marl containing the rock-salt of Cardona in Catalonia is newer than the Oolitic, if not more modern than the Cretaceous period. It is also known that certain red marls and variegated sandstones in Auvergne which are undistinguishable in mineral composition from the New Red Sandstone of English geologists, belong, nevertheless, to the Eocene period; and, lastly, the gypseous red marl of Aix, in Provence, formerly supposed to be a marine secondary group, is now acknowledged to be a tertiary freshwater formation. In Nova Scotia one great deposit of red marl, sandstone, and gypsum, precisely resembling in mineral character the "New Red" of England, occurs as a member of the Carboniferous group, and in the United States near the Falls of Niagara, a similar formation constitutes a subdivision of the Silurian series.238

But the foolishness of trying to categorize all the red sandstones and marls by age has finally been revealed, as it's been found that, even in Europe, they come from several different time periods. It's already confirmed that the red sandstone and red marl containing the rock salt of Cardona in Catalonia is younger than the Oolitic, and possibly even younger than the Cretaceous period. It's also recognized that some red marls and variegated sandstones in Auvergne, which are indistinguishable in mineral composition from the New Red Sandstone of English geologists, actually belong to the Eocene period. Lastly, the gypseous red marl of Aix in Provence, once thought to be a marine secondary group, is now known to be a tertiary freshwater formation. In Nova Scotia, there’s a large deposit of red marl, sandstone, and gypsum that closely resembles the "New Red" of England, which is part of the Carboniferous group, and in the United States near the Falls of Niagara, a similar formation is a subdivision of the Silurian series.238

Nor was the nomenclature commonly adopted in geology without its influence in perpetuating the erroneous doctrine of universal formations. Such names, for example, as Chalk, Green Sand, Oolite, Red Marl, Coal, and others, were given to some of the principal fossiliferous groups in consequence of mineral peculiarities which happened to characterize them in the countries where they were first studied. When geologists had at length shown, by means of fossils and the order of superposition, that other strata, entirely dissimilar in color, texture, and composition, were of contemporaneous date, it was thought convenient still to retain the old names. That these were often inappropriate was admitted; but the student was taught to understand them in no other than a chronological sense; so that the Chalk might not be a white cretaceous rock, but a hard dolomitic limestone, as in the Alps, or a brown sandstone or green marl, as in New Jersey, U. S. In like manner, the 159 Green Sand, it was said, might in some places be represented by red sandstone, red marl, salt, and gypsum, as in the north of Spain. So the oolitic texture was declared to be rather an exception than otherwise to the general rule in rocks of the Oolitic period; and it often became necessary to affirm that no particle of carbonaceous matter could be detected in districts where the true Coal series abounded. In spite of every precaution the habitual use of this language could scarcely fail to instil into the mind of the pupil an idea that chalk, coal, salt, red marl, or the Oolitic structure were far more widely characteristic of the rocks of a given age than was really the case.

Nor was the naming convention commonly used in geology without its impact on maintaining the incorrect idea of universal formations. Names like Chalk, Green Sand, Oolite, Red Marl, Coal, and others were assigned to some of the main fossil-rich groups because of the unique mineral features that were found in the places where they were first examined. When geologists eventually demonstrated, using fossils and the order of layers, that other strata, completely different in color, texture, and composition, were from the same time period, it was considered easier to keep the old names. It was acknowledged that these names were often inappropriate; however, students were instructed to interpret them only in a chronological way, meaning that Chalk didn’t necessarily have to be a white cretaceous rock but could be a hard dolomitic limestone, like in the Alps, or a brown sandstone or green marl, as found in New Jersey, U.S. Similarly, the Green Sand was said to be represented in certain areas by red sandstone, red marl, salt, and gypsum, as seen in northern Spain. The oolitic texture was noted to be more of an exception than the rule for rocks from the Oolitic period; it often became necessary to state that no traces of carbonaceous material could be found in regions where true Coal deposits were plentiful. Despite all precautions, the regular use of this terminology could hardly avoid giving students the impression that chalk, coal, salt, red marl, or the Oolitic structure were much more representative of the rocks from a specific age than they actually were.

There is still another cause of deception, disposing us to ascribe a more limited range to the newer sedimentary formations as compared to the older, namely, the very general concealment of the newer strata beneath the waters of lakes and seas, and the wide exposure above waters of the more ancient. The Chalk, for example, now seen stretching for thousands of miles over different parts of Europe, has become visible to us by the effect, not of one, but of many distinct series of subterranean movements. Time has been required, and a succession of geological periods, to raise it above the waves in so many regions; and if calcareous rocks of the middle and upper tertiary periods have been formed, as homogeneous in mineral composition throughout equally extensive regions, it may require convulsions as numerous as all those which have occurred since the origin of the Chalk to bring them up within the sphere of human observation. Hence the rocks of more modern periods may appear partial, as compared to those of remoter eras, not because of any original inferiority in their extent, but because there has not been sufficient time since their origin for the development of a great series of elevatory movements.

There is yet another reason for misunderstanding, leading us to consider the newer sedimentary formations as having a more limited range compared to the older ones. This is mainly due to the fact that newer layers are often hidden under the waters of lakes and seas, while the older formations are widely exposed above the water. For instance, the Chalk, which can be seen stretching for thousands of miles across various parts of Europe, has become visible not due to a single event but rather a series of distinct underground movements. It took time and numerous geological periods to elevate it above the waves in so many areas. If calcareous rocks from the middle and upper tertiary periods have formed with similar mineral compositions across equally large regions, it might take as many upheavals as those that have happened since the Chalk's formation to bring them into view for us. Therefore, the rocks from more recent periods may seem less extensive compared to those from earlier times, not because they are inherently smaller, but because there hasn't been enough time since their formation for a significant number of elevating movements to occur.

In regard, however, to one of the most important characteristics of sedimentary rocks, their organic remains, many naturalists of high authority have maintained that the same species of fossils are more uniformly distributed through formations of high antiquity than in those of more modern date, and that distinct zoological and botanical provinces, as they are called, which form so striking a feature in the living creation, were not established at remote eras. Thus the plants of the Coal, the shells, the trilobites of the Silurian rocks, and the ammonites of the Oolite, have been supposed to have a wider geographical range than any living species of plants, crustaceans, or mollusks. This opinion seems in certain cases to be well founded, especially in relation to the plants of the Carboniferous epoch, owing probably to the more uniform temperature of the globe, at a time when the position of sea and land was less favorable to variations in climate, according to principles already explained in the seventh and eighth chapters. But a recent comparison of the fossils of North American rocks with those of corresponding ages in the European series, has proved that the terrestrial vegetation of the Carboniferous epoch is an exception to the general rule, and that the fauna and flora of the earth at successive periods, 160 from the oldest Silurian to the newest Tertiary was as diversified as now. The shells, corals, and other classes of organic remains demonstrate the fact that the earth might then have been divided into separate zoological provinces, in a manner analogous to that observed in the geographical distribution of species now living.

In terms of one of the most important traits of sedimentary rocks, their organic remains, many respected naturalists have argued that the same types of fossils are more consistently found in older formations than in more recent ones. They suggest that distinct zoological and botanical regions, which are such a noticeable part of living organisms today, were not established in ancient times. For example, the plants from the Coal period, the shells, the trilobites from the Silurian rocks, and the ammonites from the Oolite are believed to have had a broader geographical distribution than any living plant, crustacean, or mollusk species. This view seems to be particularly valid regarding the plants of the Carboniferous period, likely due to the more consistent global temperature at a time when the arrangement of land and sea was less conducive to variations in climate, as previously detailed in chapters seven and eight. However, a recent comparison of fossils from North American rocks to those of the same ages in Europe shows that the land vegetation from the Carboniferous period is an exception to this general trend. It indicates that the fauna and flora of the Earth during different times, from the oldest Silurian to the most recent Tertiary, were just as diverse as they are today. The shells, corals, and other types of organic remains support the idea that the Earth could have been divided into distinct zoological regions, similar to how species are distributed geographically now.


CHAPTER XI.

ON THE SUPPOSED FORMER INTENSITY OF THE IGNEOUS FORCES.

Volcanic action at successive geological periods—Plutonic rocks of different ages—Gradual development of subterranean movements—Faults—Doctrine of the sudden upheaval of parallel mountain-chains—Objections to the proof of the suddenness of the upheaval, and the contemporaneousness of parallel chains—Trains of active volcanoes not parallel—As large tracts of land are rising or sinking slowly, so narrow zones of land may be pushed up gradually to great heights—Bending of strata by lateral pressure—Adequacy of the volcanic power to effect this without paroxysmal convulsions.

Volcanic activity over different geological periods—Plutonic rocks of various ages—The gradual development of underground movements—Faults—The idea of sudden uplift of parallel mountain ranges—Arguments against the evidence for the suddenness of this uplift and the simultaneous existence of parallel ranges—Chains of active volcanoes are not parallel—Just as large areas of land may slowly rise or sink, narrower strips of land can be gradually pushed up to significant heights—Bending of rock layers due to lateral pressure—Sufficiency of volcanic power to bring this about without explosive eruptions.

When reasoning on the intensity of volcanic action at former periods, as well as on the power of moving water, already treated of, geologists have been ever prone to represent Nature as having been prodigal of violence and parsimonious of time. Now, although it is less easy to determine the relative ages of the volcanic than of the fossiliferous formations, it is undeniable that igneous rocks have been produced at all geological periods, or as often as we find distinct deposits marked by peculiar animal and vegetable remains. It can be shown that rocks commonly called trappean have been injected into fissures, and ejected at the surface, both before and during the deposition of the Carboniferous series, and at the time when the Magnesian Limestone, and when the Upper New Red Sandstone were formed, or when the Lias, Oolite, Green Sand, Chalk, and the several tertiary groups newer than the chalk, originated in succession. Nor is this all: distinct volcanic products may be referred to the subordinate divisions of each period, such as the Carboniferous, as in the county of Fife, in Scotland, where certain masses of contemporaneous trap are associated with the Lower, others with the Upper Coal measures. And if one of these masses is more minutely examined, we find it to consist of the products of a great many successive outbursts, by which scoriæ and lava were again and again emitted, and afterwards consolidated, then fissured, and finally traversed by melted matter, constituting what are called dikes.239 As we enlarge, therefore, our knowledge of the ancient rocks formed by 161 subterranean heat, we find ourselves compelled to regard them as the aggregate effects of innumerable eruptions, each of which may have been comparable in violence to those now experienced in volcanic regions.

When examining the intensity of past volcanic activity and the power of moving water, as previously discussed, geologists have often depicted Nature as being very violent while being stingy with time. Although it's harder to determine the ages of volcanic formations compared to fossil-bearing ones, it's clear that igneous rocks have formed throughout all geological periods, as often as we find distinct layers with unique animal and plant fossils. It's been shown that rocks typically called trappean have been pushed into cracks and brought to the surface both before and during the formation of the Carboniferous layers, as well as during the creation of the Magnesian Limestone, Upper New Red Sandstone, Lias, Oolite, Green Sand, Chalk, and various tertiary groups that followed the chalk. Additionally, specific volcanic products can be linked to smaller divisions within each period, such as the Carboniferous period in Fife, Scotland, where certain layers of contemporaneous trap are found with the Lower Coal measures and others with the Upper Coal measures. If we take a closer look at one of these layers, we see it made up of materials from many successive eruptions, during which ash and lava were repeatedly released, consolidated, cracked, and ultimately crossed by molten matter, forming what we call dikes.239 As we expand our understanding of the ancient rocks created by underground heat, we have to recognize them as the combined results of countless eruptions, each potentially as forceful as those we see in volcanic areas today.

It may indeed be said that we have as yet no data for estimating the relative volume of matter simultaneously in a state of fusion at two given periods, as if we were to compare the columnar basalt of Staffa and its environs with the lava poured out in Iceland in 1783; but for this very reason it would be rash and unphilosophical to assume an excess of ancient as contrasted with modern outpourings of melted matter at particular periods of time.240 It would be still more presumptuous to take for granted that the more deep-seated effects of subterranean heat surpassed at remote eras the corresponding effects of internal heat in our own times. Certain porphyries and granites, and all the rocks commonly called plutonic, are now generally supposed to have resulted from the slow cooling of materials fused and solidified under great pressure; and we cannot doubt that beneath existing volcanoes there are large spaces filled with melted stone, which must for centuries remain in an incandescent state, and then cool and become hard and crystalline when the subterranean heat shall be exhausted. That lakes of lava are continuous for hundreds of miles beneath the Chilian Andes, seems established by observations made in the year 1835.241

We currently don't have any data to estimate the amount of matter that was molten at two different times, such as comparing the columnar basalt of Staffa and its surroundings with the lava that erupted in Iceland in 1783. Therefore, it would be reckless and unscientific to assume that ancient lava flows were greater than modern ones during specific periods. It would be even more arrogant to believe that the deep-seated effects of underground heat were stronger in the past than the effects of internal heat today. Certain porphyries and granites, as well as all rocks typically called plutonic, are now thought to have formed from the gradual cooling of materials that were melted and solidified under extreme pressure. We cannot deny that beneath today's volcanoes, there are large areas filled with molten rock, which will remain in a liquid state for centuries before eventually cooling and becoming hard and crystalline once the subterranean heat dissipates. Data collected in 1835 suggests that lakes of lava stretch for hundreds of miles beneath the Chilian Andes.

Now, wherever the fluid contents of such reservoirs are poured out successively from craters in the open air, or at the bottom of the sea, the matter so ejected may afford evidence by its arrangement of having originated at different periods; but if the subterranean residue after the withdrawal of the heat be converted into crystalline or plutonic rock, the entire mass may seem to have been formed at once, however countless the ages required for its fusion and subsequent refrigeration. As the idea that all the granite in the earth's crust was produced simultaneously, and in a primitive state of the planet, has now been universally abandoned; so the suggestion above adverted to, may put us on our guard against too readily adopting another opinion, namely, that each large mass of granite was generated in a brief period of time.

Now, whenever the liquid contents of these reservoirs are released from craters, either into the open air or at the bottom of the sea, the material that comes out may show evidence of different origins based on its arrangement. However, if the leftover material underground solidifies into crystalline or plutonic rock after the heat is gone, the entire mass may appear to have formed at the same time, no matter how many ages it took to melt and then cool down. Just as the idea that all the granite in the Earth's crust formed at the same time during the planet's early state has been completely rejected, the suggestion mentioned here should remind us to be cautious about quickly accepting another belief—that each large mass of granite was created in a short period of time.

Modern writers indeed, of authority, seem more and more agreed that in the case of granitic rocks, the passage from a liquid or pasty to a solid and crystalline state must have been an extremely gradual process.

Modern writers in authority seem increasingly united in their belief that for granitic rocks, the transition from a liquid or gooey state to a solid and crystalline one must have been a very gradual process.

The doctrine so much insisted upon formerly, that crystalline rocks, such as granite, gneiss, mica-schist, quartzite, and others were produced in the greatest abundance in the earlier ages of the planet, and that their formation has ceased altogether in our own times, will be controverted in the next chapter.

The idea that was strongly emphasized in the past—that crystalline rocks like granite, gneiss, mica-schist, quartzite, and others were formed in large quantities during the early ages of the planet, and that their formation has completely stopped in our time—will be challenged in the next chapter.

Gradual development of subterranean movements.—The extreme violence of the subterranean forces in remote ages has been often inferred from the facts that the older rocks are more fractured and dislocated 162 than the newer. But what other result could we have anticipated if the quantity of movement had been always equal in equal periods of time? Time must, in that case, multiply the derangement of strata in the ratio of their antiquity. Indeed the numerous exceptions to the above rule which we find in nature, present at first sight the only objection to the hypothesis of uniformity. For the more ancient formations remain in many places horizontal, while in others much newer strata are curved and vertical. This apparent anomaly, however, will be seen in the next chapter to depend on the irregular manner in which the volcanic and subterranean agency affect different parts of the earth in succession, being often renewed again and again in certain areas, while others remain during the whole time at rest.

Gradual development of underground movements.—The extreme force of underground activity in ancient times is often inferred from the fact that older rocks are more fractured and displaced 162 than newer ones. But what other outcome could we expect if the amount of movement had been consistently equal over equal periods? Time must, in that case, increase the disruption of layers in proportion to their age. In fact, the many exceptions to this rule that we observe in nature seem to present the only counterargument to the idea of uniformity. The more ancient formations remain horizontal in many areas, while in others, comparatively younger layers are curved and vertical. However, this apparent inconsistency will be explained in the next chapter, as it relates to the irregular ways in which volcanic and underground forces impact different parts of the Earth over time, often being renewed repeatedly in certain regions while others remain undisturbed throughout.

That the more impressive effects of subterranean power, such as the upheaval of mountain-chains, may have been due to multiplied convulsions of moderate intensity rather than to a few paroxysmal explosions, will appear the less improbable when the gradual and intermittent development of volcanic eruptions in times past is once established. It is now very generally conceded that these eruptions have their source in the same causes as those which give rise to the permanent elevation and sinking of land; the admission, therefore, that one of the two volcanic or subterranean processes has gone on gradually, draws with it the conclusion that the effects of the other have been elaborated by successive and gradual efforts.

That the more impressive effects of underground power, such as the upheaval of mountain ranges, may have been caused by repeated tremors of moderate intensity instead of a few explosive eruptions will seem less unlikely once we recognize the gradual and intermittent development of volcanic eruptions in the past. It's now widely accepted that these eruptions come from the same causes that lead to the permanent rise and fall of land. Therefore, if we acknowledge that one of these volcanic or underground processes happens gradually, we can conclude that the effects of the other have been produced through ongoing and gradual efforts.

Faults.—The same reasoning is applicable to great faults, or those striking instances of the upthrow or downthrow of large masses of rock, which have been thought by some to imply tremendous catastrophes wholly foreign to the ordinary course of nature. Thus we have in England faults, in which the vertical displacement is between 600 and 3000 feet, and the horizontal extent thirty miles or more, the width of the fissures since filled up with rubbish varying from ten to fifty feet. But when we inquire into the proofs of the mass having risen or fallen suddenly on the one side of these great rents, several hundreds or thousands of feet above or below the rock with which it was once continuous on the other side, we find the evidence defective. There are grooves, it is said, and scratches on the rubbed and polished walls, which have often one common direction, favoring the theory that the movement was accomplished by a single stroke, and not by a series of interrupted movements. But, in fact, the striæ are not always parallel in such cases, but often irregular, and sometimes the stones and earth which are in the middle of the fault, or fissure, have been polished and striated by friction in different directions, showing that there have been slidings subsequent to the first introduction of the fragmentary matter. Nor should we forget that the last movement must always tend to obliterate the signs of previous trituration, so that neither its instantaneousness nor the uniformity of its direction can be inferred from the parallelism of the striæ that have been last produced.

Faults.—The same reasoning applies to major faults, or those noticeable instances of the upthrow or downthrow of large rock masses, which some have believed indicate massive catastrophes unrelated to the normal course of nature. In England, for example, we have faults where the vertical displacement ranges from 600 to 3000 feet, and the horizontal extent is thirty miles or more, with the width of the fissures, now filled with debris, varying from ten to fifty feet. However, when we look for proof that the mass suddenly rose or fell on one side of these great fractures, several hundreds or thousands of feet above or below the rock it was once joined to on the other side, we find the evidence lacking. There are grooves and scratches on the rubbed and polished surfaces, which often share a common direction, supporting the idea that the movement occurred in one single motion, rather than through a series of interrupted movements. However, in reality, the striations are not always parallel in such scenarios; they are often uneven, and sometimes the stones and earth in the middle of the fault or fissure have been polished and striated by friction in different directions, indicating that there have been movements after the initial introduction of the fragmented material. We should also remember that the last movement tends to erase the signs of previous grinding, so we cannot assume either its immediacy or the uniformity of its direction from the parallelism of the most recently created striations.

When rocks have been once fractured, and freedom of motion communicated 163 to detached portions of them, these will naturally continue to yield in the same direction, if the process of upheaval or of undermining be repeated again and again. The incumbent mass will always give way along the lines of least resistance, or where it was formerly rent asunder. Probably, the effects of reiterated movement, whether upward or downward, in a fault, may be undistinguishable from those of a single and instantaneous rise or subsidence; and the same may be said of the rising or falling of continental masses, such as Sweden or Greenland, which we know to take place slowly and insensibly.

When rocks have been fractured and allow for movement among their detached pieces, those pieces will naturally keep shifting in the same direction if the processes of upheaval or erosion are repeatedly applied. The weight above will always move along the paths of least resistance, or where it was previously broken apart. The effects of repeated movements, whether upward or downward in a fault, might be indistinguishable from those of a single, instant rise or drop. The same applies to the rising or falling of continental masses like Sweden or Greenland, which we know happens slowly and imperceptibly.

Doctrine of the sudden upheaval of parallel mountain-chains.—The doctrine of the suddenness of many former revolutions in the physical geography of the globe has been thought by some to derive additional confirmation from a theory respecting the origin of mountain-chains, advanced in 1833 by a distinguished geologist, M. Elie de Beaumont. In several essays on this subject, the last published in 1852, he has attempted to establish two points; first, that a variety of independent chains of mountains have been thrown up suddenly at particular periods; and, secondly, that the contemporaneous chains thus thrown up, preserve a parallelism the one to the other.

Doctrine of the Sudden Uplift of Parallel Mountain Chains.—Some people believe that the idea of sudden changes in the Earth's physical geography is supported by a theory about how mountain chains form, proposed in 1833 by the renowned geologist M. Elie de Beaumont. In several essays on this topic, the last one published in 1852, he has tried to establish two points: first, that different independent mountain chains have been suddenly uplifted at specific times; and second, that these contemporaneous chains maintain a parallel alignment with each other.

These opinions, and others by which they are accompanied, are so adverse to the method of interpreting the history of geological changes which I have recommended in this work, that I am desirous of explaining the grounds of my dissent, a course which I feel myself the more called upon to adopt, as the generalizations alluded to are those of a skilful writer, and an original observer of great talent and experience. I shall begin, therefore, by giving a brief summary of the principal propositions laid down in the works above referred to.242

These opinions, along with others that accompany them, strongly oppose the way I’ve suggested interpreting the history of geological changes in this work. I feel it's important to explain why I disagree, especially since the generalizations mentioned come from a skilled writer and a highly talented and experienced original observer. So, I’ll start by providing a brief summary of the main points made in the works mentioned above.242

1st. M. de Beaumont supposes "that in the history of the earth there have been long periods of comparative repose, during which the deposition of sedimentary matter has gone on in regular continuity; and there have also been short periods of paroxysmal violence, during which that continuity was broken.

1st. M. de Beaumont suggests "that throughout the history of the Earth, there have been long stretches of relative calm, where the deposition of sedimentary material occurred steadily; and there have also been brief episodes of explosive violence, during which that steadiness was interrupted.

"2dly. At each of these periods of violence or 'revolution,' in the state of the earth's surface, a great number of mountain-chains have been formed suddenly.

"2dly. During each of these times of violence or 'revolution' in the earth's surface, a large number of mountain ranges have formed rapidly."

"3dly. The chains thrown up by a particular revolution have one uniform direction, being parallel to each other within a few degrees of the compass, even when situated in remote regions; whilst the chains thrown up at different periods have, for the most part, different directions.

"Thirdly, the mountain ranges formed by a specific revolution tend to all go in the same direction, staying parallel to each other within a few degrees of the compass, even when they are far apart; while the mountain ranges created at different times usually have different directions."

"4thly. Each 'revolution,' or 'great convulsion,' has fallen in with the date of another geological phenomenon; namely, 'the passage from 164 one independent sedimentary formation to another,' characterized by a considerable difference in 'organic types.'

"4thly. Each 'revolution,' or 'great convulsion,' has coincided with the date of another geological phenomenon; specifically, 'the transition from 164 one independent sedimentary formation to another,' marked by a significant difference in 'organic types.'"

"5thly. There has been a recurrence of these paroxysmal movements from the remotest geological periods; and they may still be reproduced, and the repose in which we live may hereafter be broken by the sudden upthrow of another system of parallel chains of mountains.

"5thly. These sudden movements have happened repeatedly since the earliest geological periods; they can still occur, and the calm we experience now could eventually be disrupted by the sudden rise of another set of parallel mountain ranges."

"6thly. The origin of these chains depends not on partial volcanic action, or a reiteration of ordinary earthquakes, but on the secular refrigeration of the entire planet. For the whole globe, with the exception of a thin envelope, much thinner in proportion than the shell to an egg, is a fused mass, kept fluid by heat, but constantly cooling and contracting its dimensions. The external crust does not gradually collapse and accommodate itself century after century to the shrunken nucleus, subsiding as often as there is a slight failure of support, but it is sustained throughout whole geological periods, so as to become partially separated from the nucleus, until at last it gives way suddenly, cracking and falling in along determinate lines of fracture. During such a crisis the rocks are subjected to great lateral pressure, the unyielding ones are crushed, and the pliant strata bent, and are forced to pack themselves more closely into a smaller space, having no longer the same room to spread themselves out horizontally. At the same time, a large portion of the mass is squeezed upwards, because it is in the upward direction only that the excess in size of the envelope, as compared to the contracted nucleus, can find relief. This excess produces one or more of those folds or wrinkles in the earth's crust which we call mountain-chains.

"6thly. The origin of these mountain ranges doesn’t come from volcanic activity or regular earthquakes but rather from the gradual cooling of the entire planet. The whole Earth, except for a thin layer much smaller in proportion than an eggshell, is a molten mass kept liquid by heat but constantly cooling and shrinking. The outer crust doesn’t slowly cave in and adjust itself over centuries to the shrinking core, settling each time there’s a minor decrease in support; instead, it remains stable for entire geological periods, becoming partially detached from the core until it eventually gives way suddenly, cracking and collapsing along specific lines of fracture. During these events, the rocks experience significant lateral pressure; the rigid ones get crushed, and the flexible layers bend and are compressed into a smaller space since they no longer have room to spread out horizontally. At the same time, a large portion of the mass is pushed upwards because the only way the excess size of the layer, compared to the contracted core, can relieve itself is in that upward direction. This excess results in one or more of the folds or wrinkles in the Earth’s crust that we refer to as mountain ranges."

"Lastly, some chains are comparatively modern; such as the Alps, which were partly upheaved after the middle tertiary period. The elevation of the Andes was much more recent, and was accompanied by the simultaneous outburst for the first time of 270 of the principal volcanoes now active.243

"Lastly, some mountain ranges are relatively modern, like the Alps, which were partially raised after the middle tertiary period. The rise of the Andes happened much more recently and was marked by the first-time eruption of 270 of the main volcanoes that are currently active.243

"The agitation of the waters of the ocean caused by this convulsion probably occasioned that transient and general deluge which is noticed in the traditions of so many nations."244

"The disturbance of the ocean waters caused by this upheaval probably led to that temporary and widespread flood mentioned in the legends of many cultures."244

Several of the topics enumerated in the above summary, such as the cause of interruptions in the sedimentary series, will be discussed in the thirteenth chapter, and I shall now confine myself to what I conceive to be the insufficiency of the proofs adduced in favor of the suddenness of the upthrow, and the contemporaneousness of the origin of the parallel chains referred to. At the same time I may remark, that the great body of facts collected together by M. de Beaumont will always form a most valuable addition to our knowledge, tending as they do to confirm the doctrine that different mountain-chains have been formed in succession, and, as Werner first pointed out, that there are certain determinate lines of direction or strike in the strata of various countries.

Several of the topics mentioned in the summary above, like the reasons for interruptions in the sedimentary layers, will be discussed in the thirteenth chapter. For now, I’ll focus on what I believe to be the lack of sufficient evidence supporting the idea that the upthrow happened suddenly and that the parallel mountain ranges originated at the same time. I should also note that the extensive collection of facts gathered by M. de Beaumont will always be a valuable addition to our understanding, as it supports the idea that different mountain ranges were formed in succession and, as Werner first noted, that there are specific lines of direction or strike in the strata of various regions.

165The following may serve as an analysis of the evidence on which the theory above stated depends. "We observe," says M. de Beaumont, "when we attentively examine nearly all mountain-chains, that the most recent rocks extend horizontally up to the foot of such chains, as we should expect would be the case if they were deposited in seas or lakes, of which these mountains have partly formed the shores; whilst the other sedimentary beds, tilted up, and more or less contorted, on the flanks of the mountains, rise in certain points even to their highest crests."245 There are, therefore, in and adjacent to each chain, two classes of sedimentary rocks, the ancient and inclined beds, and the newer or horizontal. It is evident that the first appearance of the chain itself was an event "intermediate between the period when the beds now upraised were deposited, and the period when the strata were produced horizontally at its feet."

165The following can serve as an analysis of the evidence supporting the theory mentioned above. "We notice," says M. de Beaumont, "when we carefully examine almost all mountain ranges, that the newest rocks spread out horizontally up to the base of these ranges, which is what we would expect if they were deposited in seas or lakes that these mountains have partly shaped the shores of; while the other sedimentary layers, tilted and somewhat distorted, on the sides of the mountains, rise at certain points all the way to their highest peaks." 245 Thus, in and around each range, there are two types of sedimentary rocks: the older, tilted layers, and the newer, horizontal ones. It is clear that the formation of the range itself was an event "intermediate between the period when the currently uplifted layers were deposited and the period when the layers were formed horizontally at its base."

Fig. 11.Chain A.

Thus the chain A assumed its present position after the deposition of the strata b, which have undergone great movements, and before the deposition of the group c, in which the strata have not suffered derangement.

Thus the chain A took its current position after the layers b were deposited, which experienced significant movements, and before the layers c were deposited, in which the strata have not been disturbed.

Fig. 12.Chain B.

If we then discover another chain B, in which we find not only the formation b, but the group c also, disturbed and thrown on its edges, we may infer that the latter chain is of subsequent date to A; for B must have been elevated after the deposition of c, and before that of the group d; whereas A had originated before the strata c were formed.

If we then find another chain B, where we see not just the formation b, but also the group c, disrupted and tilted, we can conclude that this chain is younger than A; because B must have risen after the deposition of c, and before that of the group d; while A must have formed before the strata c came into existence.

It is then argued, that in order to ascertain whether other mountain ranges are of contemporaneous date with A and B, or are referable to distinct periods, we have only to inquire whether the inclined and undisturbed sets of strata in each range correspond with or differ from those in the typical chain A and B.

It is then argued that to determine if other mountain ranges are from the same time period as A and B, or belong to different periods, we just need to ask whether the tilted and undisturbed layers of rock in each range match or differ from those in the typical ranges A and B.

Now all this reasoning is perfectly correct, so long as the period of time required for the deposition of the strata b and c is not made identical 166 in duration with the period of time during which the animals and plants found fossil in b and c may have flourished; for the latter, that is to say, the duration of certain groups of species, may have greatly exceeded, and probably did greatly exceed, the former, or the time required for the accumulation of certain local deposits, such as b and c (figs. 11 and 12). In order, moreover, to render the reasoning correct, due latitude must be given to the term contemporaneous; for this term must be understood to allude, not to a moment of time, but to the interval, whether brief or protracted, which elapsed between two events, namely, between the accumulation of the inclined and that of the horizontal strata.

Now, all this reasoning is completely valid, as long as the time required for the deposition of the layers b and c isn't assumed to be the same length as the time during which the animals and plants found as fossils in b and c might have thrived. The duration of certain groups of species could have lasted much longer, and probably did, than the time it took to accumulate specific local deposits like b and c (figs. 11 and 12). Additionally, to make the reasoning accurate, the term contemporaneous needs to have some flexibility; it should be understood as referring to the interval, whether short or long, that occurred between two events: the accumulation of the inclined strata and that of the horizontal strata.

But, unfortunately, no attempt has been made in the treatises under review to avoid this manifest source of confusion, and hence the very terms of each proposition are equivocal; and the possible length of some of the intervals is so vast, that to affirm that all the chains raised in such intervals were contemporaneous is an abuse of language.

But, unfortunately, there has been no effort in the works being discussed to eliminate this obvious source of confusion, so the wording of each statement is unclear; and the potential length of some of the gaps is so immense that claiming all the chains formed during those gaps were contemporaneous is a misuse of language.

In order to illustrate this argument, I shall select the Pyrenees as an example. Originally M. E. de Beaumont spoke of this range of mountains as having been uplifted suddenly (à un seul jet), but he has since conceded that in this chain, in spite of the general unity and simplicity of its structure, six, if not seven, systems of dislocation of different dates can be recognized.246 In reference, however, to the latest, and by far the most important of these convulsions, the chain is said to have attained its present elevation at a certain epoch in the earth's history, namely, between the deposition of the chalk, or rocks of about that age, and that of certain tertiary formations "as old as the plastic clay;" for the chalk is seen in vertical, curved, and distorted beds on the flanks of the chain, as the beds b, fig. 11, while the tertiary formations rest upon them in horizontal strata at its base, as c, ibid.

To illustrate this argument, I will use the Pyrenees as an example. Originally, M. E. de Beaumont described this mountain range as being uplifted suddenly (i.e., in one go), but he has since acknowledged that within this chain, despite its overall unity and simplicity, there are six, if not seven, systems of dislocation from different periods that can be identified.246 Regarding, however, the most recent and significant of these disruptions, it is said that the chain reached its current height during a specific time in Earth's history, specifically between the deposition of the chalk, or rocks of a similar age, and certain tertiary formations "as old as the plastic clay"; because the chalk appears in vertical, curved, and distorted layers on the sides of the chain, as shown in the beds b, fig. 11, while the tertiary formations lie upon them in horizontal layers at its base, as c, ibid.

The proof, then, of the extreme suddenness of the convulsion is supposed to be the shortness of the time which intervened between the formation of the chalk and the origin of certain tertiary strata.247 Even if the interval were deducible within these limits, it might comprise an indefinite lapse of time. In strictness of reasoning, however, the author cannot exclude the Cretaceous or Tertiary periods from the possible duration of the interval during which the elevation may have taken place. For, in the first place, it cannot be assumed that the movement of upheaval took place after the close of the Cretaceous period; we can merely say, that it occurred after the deposition of certain strata of that period; secondly, although it were true that the event happened before the formation of all the tertiary strata now at the base of the Pyrenees, it would by no means follow that it preceded the whole Tertiary epoch.

The proof of how sudden the upheaval was is thought to be the brief time between the formation of the chalk and the start of certain tertiary layers.247 Even if we could figure out that the gap was short, it could still represent an undefined stretch of time. However, in all fairness, the author can’t rule out the Cretaceous or Tertiary periods as part of the potential duration of the interval when the uplift may have happened. First, we can’t assume that the uplift occurred after the end of the Cretaceous period; we can only state that it happened after some layers from that period were deposited. Second, even if it’s true that the event took place before all the tertiary layers now found at the base of the Pyrenees, that doesn’t mean it happened before the entire Tertiary era.

The age of the strata, both of the inclined and horizontal series, may 167 have been accurately determined by M. De Beaumont, and still the upheaving of the Pyrenees may have been going on before the animals of the Chalk period, such as are found fossil in England, had ceased to exist, or when the Maestricht beds were in progress, or during the indefinite ages which may have elapsed between the extinction of the Maestricht animals and the introduction of the Eocene tribes, or during the Eocene epoch, or the rise may have been going on throughout one, or several, or all of these periods.

The age of the rock layers, both the slanted and flat ones, may 167 have been accurately established by M. De Beaumont, yet the lifting of the Pyrenees might have started before the animals from the Chalk period, like those found as fossils in England, disappeared, or while the Maestricht layers were forming, or during the long time that might have passed between the extinction of the Maestricht animals and the emergence of the Eocene species, or during the Eocene period itself. The uplift may have occurred during one, several, or even all of these times.

It would be a purely gratuitous assumption to say that the inclined cretaceous strata (b, fig. 11.) on the flanks of the Pyrenees, were the very last which were deposited during the Cretaceous period, or that, as soon as they were upheaved, all or nearly all the species of animals and plants now found fossil in them were suddenly exterminated; yet, unless this can be affirmed, we cannot say that the Pyrenees were not upheaved during the Cretaceous period. Consequently, another range of mountains, at the base of which cretaceous rocks may lie in horizontal stratification, may have been elevated, like the chain A, fig. 12, during some part of the same great period.

It would be a completely unfounded assumption to say that the tilted Cretaceous layers (b, fig. 11.) on the sides of the Pyrenees were the very last ones deposited during the Cretaceous period, or that, as soon as they were raised, all or nearly all the species of animals and plants now found fossilized in them were suddenly wiped out; however, unless this can be confirmed, we can't say that the Pyrenees weren't raised during the Cretaceous period. Therefore, another mountain range, where Cretaceous rocks might be lying flat, could have been uplifted, like the chain A, fig. 12, during some part of the same significant period.

There are mountains in Sicily two or three thousand feet high, the tops of which are composed of limestone, in which a large proportion of the fossil shells agree specifically with those now inhabiting the Mediterranean. Here, as in many other countries, the deposits now in progress in the sea must inclose shells and other fossils specifically identical with those of the rocks constituting the contiguous land. So there are islands in the Pacific where a mass of dead coral has emerged to a considerable altitude, while other portions of the mass remain beneath the sea, still increasing by the growth of living zoophytes and shells. The chalk of the Pyrenees, therefore, may at a remote period have been raised to an elevation of several thousand feet, while the species found fossil in the same chalk still continued to be represented in the fauna of the neighboring ocean. In a word, we cannot assume that the origin of a new range of mountains caused the Cretaceous period to cease, and served as the prelude to a new order of things in the animate creation.

There are mountains in Sicily that rise two or three thousand feet high, with tops made of limestone, which contain a large number of fossil shells that match those currently living in the Mediterranean. Just like in many other places, the ongoing deposits in the sea must include shells and other fossils that are specifically identical to those found in the rocks of the nearby land. There are also islands in the Pacific where a large mass of dead coral has risen to a significant height, while other parts of this mass remain underwater, still growing through the development of living zoophytes and shells. The chalk in the Pyrenees may have been lifted to several thousand feet in the past, while the species found as fossils in that same chalk continued to be present in the fauna of the nearby ocean. In summary, we cannot assume that the formation of a new mountain range led to the end of the Cretaceous period and marked the beginning of a new era in living beings.

To illustrate the grave objections above advanced, against the theory considered in the present chapter, let us suppose, that in some country three styles of architecture had prevailed in succession, each for a period of one thousand years; first the Greek, then the Roman, and then the Gothic; and that a tremendous earthquake was known to have occurred in the same district during one of the three periods—a convulsion of such violence as to have levelled to the ground all the buildings then standing. If an antiquary, desirous of discovering the date of the catastrophe, should first arrive at a city where several Greek temples were lying in ruins and half engulphed in the earth, while many Gothic edifices were standing uninjured, could he determine on these data the era of the shock? Could he even exclude any one of the three periods, and decide that it must have happened during one of the other two? Certainly not. He could merely affirm that it happened at some period 168 after the introduction of the Greek style, and before the Gothic had fallen into disuse. Should he pretend to define the date of the convulsion with greater precision, and decide that the earthquake must have occurred after the Greek and before the Gothic period, that is to say, when the Roman style was in use, the fallacy in his reasoning would be too palpable to escape detection for a moment.

To showcase the serious objections mentioned earlier against the theory presented in this chapter, let’s imagine a scenario where three architectural styles dominated in a certain country, each for a thousand years: first the Greek, then the Roman, and finally the Gothic. During one of these periods, a massive earthquake struck the region—a violent event that flattened all the buildings standing at that time. If an antiquarian, eager to determine when this disaster occurred, arrived in a city where several Greek temples lay in ruins, partially buried in the ground, while many Gothic structures stood intact, could he figure out when the earthquake happened? Could he rule out any of the three periods and conclude it must have occurred during one of the other two? Definitely not. He could only state that it took place at some time 168 after the Greek style was introduced and before the Gothic style went out of fashion. If he attempted to pinpoint the date of the quake more precisely by claiming it occurred after the Greek period and before the Gothic, meaning during the Roman period, the flaw in his reasoning would be too obvious to overlook for even a moment.

Yet such is the nature of the erroneous induction which I am now exposing. For as, in the example above proposed, the erection of a particular edifice is perfectly distinct from the period of architecture in which it may have been raised, so is the deposition of chalk, or any other set of strata, from the geological epochs characterized by certain fossils to which they may belong.

Yet this is the nature of the wrong conclusion I am now revealing. Just as in the example given above, the construction of a specific building is completely separate from the period of architecture in which it was built, the accumulation of chalk, or any other group of layers, is also separate from the geological times marked by certain fossils to which they may be linked.

It is almost superfluous to enter into any farther analysis of the theory of parallelism, because the whole force of the argument depends on the accuracy of the data by which the contemporaneous or non-contemporaneous date of the elevation of two independent chains can be demonstrated. In every case, this evidence, as stated by M. de Beaumont, is equivocal, because he has not included in the possible interval of time between the depositions of the deranged and the horizontal formations, part of the periods to which each of those classes of formations are referable. Even if all the geological facts, therefore, adduced by the author were true and unquestionable, yet the conclusion that certain chains were or were not simultaneously upraised is by no means a legitimate consequence.

It’s almost pointless to go further into the theory of parallelism because the argument's strength relies on the accuracy of the data that shows whether two independent mountain ranges were raised at the same time or not. In every case, this evidence, as stated by M. de Beaumont, is ambiguous, since he hasn't accounted for the time span between the formation of the disturbed layers and the horizontal layers, which overlaps with the periods relevant to each of those formation types. Therefore, even if all the geological facts presented by the author were completely true and indisputable, the conclusion that certain mountain ranges were or weren't raised simultaneously is definitely not a valid outcome.

In the third volume of my first edition of the Principles, which appeared in April, 1833, I controverted the views of M. de Beaumont, then just published, in the same terms as I have now restated them. At that time I took for granted that the chronological date of the newest rocks entering into the disturbed series of the Pyrenees had been correctly ascertained. It now appears, however, that some of the most modern of those disturbed strata belong to the nummulitic formation, which are regarded by the majority of geologists as Eocene or older tertiary, an opinion not assented to by M. E. de Beaumont, and which I cannot discuss here without being led into too long a digression.248

In the third volume of my first edition of the Principles, which came out in April 1833, I challenged M. de Beaumont's views, which had just been published, using the same arguments I’m presenting now. Back then, I assumed that the chronological age of the newest rocks in the disturbed series of the Pyrenees had been accurately determined. However, it turns out that some of the most recent disturbed layers actually belong to the nummulitic formation, which most geologists consider to be Eocene or older tertiary. This view isn’t shared by M. E. de Beaumont, and I can’t delve into it here without getting sidetracked.248

Perhaps a more striking illustration of the difficulties we encounter, when we attempt to apply the theory under consideration even to the best known European countries, is afforded by what is called "The System of the Longmynds." This small chain, situated in Shropshire, is the third of the typical systems to which M. E. de Beaumont compares other mountain ranges corresponding in strike and structure. The date assigned to its upheaval is "after the unfossiliferous greywacke, or Cambrian strata, and before the Silurian." But Sir R. I. Murchison had shown in 1838, in his "Silurian System," and the British government surveyors, since that time, in their sections (about 1845), that the Longmynds and other chains of similar composition in North Wales are post-Silurian. 169 In all of them fossiliferous beds of the lower Silurian formation, or Llandeilo flags are highly inclined, and often vertical. In one limited region the Caradoc sandstone, a member of the lower Silurian, rests unconformably on the denuded edges of the inferior (or Llandeilo) member of the same group; whilst in some cases both of these sets of strata are upturned. When, therefore, so grave an error is detected in regard to the age of a typical chain, we are entitled to inquire with surprise, by what means nine other parallel chains in France, Germany, and Sweden, assumed to be "ante-Silurian," have been made to agree precisely in date with the Longmynds? If they are correctly represented as having been all deposited before the deposition of the Silurian strata, they cannot be contemporaneous with the Longmynds, and they only prove how little reliance can be placed on parallelism as a test of simultaneousness of upheaval. But in truth it is impossible, for reasons already given, to demonstrate that each of those nine chains coincide in date with one another, any more than with the Longmynds.

Perhaps a more striking example of the challenges we face when we try to apply the theory in question, even to the most well-known European countries, is "The System of the Longmynds." This small mountain range, located in Shropshire, is the third of the typical systems to which M. E. de Beaumont compares other mountain ranges that share similar strike and structure. The date assigned to its formation is "after the unfossiliferous greywacke, or Cambrian strata, and before the Silurian." However, Sir R. I. Murchison demonstrated in 1838 in his "Silurian System," and British government surveyors since then, in their sections (around 1845), that the Longmynds and other mountain ranges with similar composition in North Wales are post-Silurian. 169 In all of them, fossiliferous beds of the lower Silurian formation, or Llandeilo flags, are highly tilted and often vertical. In one specific area, the Caradoc sandstone, a member of the lower Silurian, sits unconformably on the eroded edges of the lower (or Llandeilo) member of the same group; while in some instances, both of these sets of strata are uplifted. Therefore, when such a significant error is found concerning the age of a typical range, we are justified in wondering how nine other parallel chains in France, Germany, and Sweden, believed to be "ante-Silurian," have been aligned to have the same date as the Longmynds. If they are accurately claimed to have all been deposited before the deposition of the Silurian strata, they cannot be contemporaneous with the Longmynds, and they only highlight how little trust can be placed on parallelism as a measure of simultaneous uplift. In reality, it is impossible, for the reasons already stated, to prove that each of those nine chains coincides in date with each other, just as they do not with the Longmynds.

The reader will see in the sequel (chap. 31249) that Mr. Hopkins has inferred from astronomical calculations, that the solid crust of the earth cannot be less than 800 or 1000 miles thick, and may be more. Even if it be solid to the depth of 100 miles, such a thickness would be inconsistent with M. E. de Beaumont's hypothesis, which requires a shell not more than thirty miles thick, or even less. Mr. Hopkins admits that the exterior of the planet, though solid as a whole, may contain within it vast lakes or seas of lava. If so, the gradual fusion of rocks, and the expansive power of heat exerted for ages, as well as the subsequent contraction of the same during slow refrigeration, may perhaps account for the origin of mountain-chains, for these, as Dolomieu has remarked, are "far less important, proportionally speaking, than the inequalities on the surface of an egg-shell, which to the eye appears smooth." A "centripetal force" affecting the whole planet as it cools, seems a mightier cause than is required to produce wrinkles of such insignificant size.

The reader will see in the following section (chap. 31249) that Mr. Hopkins has inferred from astronomical calculations that the solid crust of the earth cannot be less than 800 or 1000 miles thick, and it could be even thicker. Even if it is solid to a depth of 100 miles, such thickness would contradict M. E. de Beaumont's hypothesis, which suggests a shell no thicker than thirty miles, or even less. Mr. Hopkins acknowledges that the surface of the planet, while solid overall, may contain vast lakes or seas of lava beneath. If this is the case, the gradual melting of rocks, the expansive force of heat over ages, and the subsequent contraction during slow cooling may help explain the formation of mountain ranges. As Dolomieu has pointed out, these mountains are "far less significant, proportionally speaking, than the unevenness on the surface of an eggshell, which looks smooth to the eye." A "centripetal force" acting on the entire planet as it cools seems like a much stronger cause than what is needed to create such tiny wrinkles.

In pursuing his investigations, M. E. de Beaumont has of late greatly multiplied the number of successive periods of instantaneous upheaval, admitting at the same time that occasionally new lines of upthrow have taken the direction of older ones.250 These admissions render his views much more in harmony with the principles advocated in this work, but they impair the practical utility of parallelism considered as a chronological test; for no rule is laid down for limiting the interval, whether in time or space, which may separate two parallel lines of upheaval of different dates.251

In his investigations, M. E. de Beaumont has recently greatly increased the number of successive periods of sudden upheaval, while also admitting that sometimes new lines of uplift have followed the same direction as older ones.250 These admissions align his views more closely with the principles discussed in this work, but they reduce the practical usefulness of parallelism as a chronological test; as there is no guideline for defining the interval, either in time or space, that may separate two parallel lines of upheaval from different dates.251

170 Among the various propositions above laid down (p. 164), it will be seen that the sudden rise of the Andes is spoken of as a modern event, but Mr. Darwin has brought together ample data in proof of the local persistency of volcanic action throughout a long succession of geological periods, beginning with times antecedent to the deposition of the oolitic and cretaceous formations of Chili, and continuing to the historical epoch. It appears that some of the parallel ridges which compose the Cordilleras, instead of being contemporaneous, were successively and slowly upheaved at widely different epochs. The whole range, after twice subsiding some thousands of feet, was brought up again by a slow movement in mass, during the era of the Eocene tertiary formations, after which the whole sank down once more several hundred feet, to be again uplifted to its present level by a slow and often interrupted movement.252 In a portion of this latter period the "Pampean mud" was formed, in which the Megatherium mylodon and other extinct quadrupeds are buried. This mud contains in it recent species of shells, some of them proper to brackish water, and is believed by Mr. Darwin to be an estuary or delta deposit. M. A. d'Orbigny, however, has advanced an hypothesis referred to by M. E. de Beaumont, that the agitation and displacement of the waters of the ocean, caused by the elevation of the Andes, gave rise to a deluge, of which this Pampean mud, which rises sometimes to the height of 12,000 feet, is the result and monument.253

170 Among the various points mentioned earlier (p. 164), it's noted that the abrupt rise of the Andes is considered a recent event. However, Mr. Darwin has gathered substantial evidence showing that there has been ongoing volcanic activity in this area over a long series of geological periods, starting from before the formation of the oolitic and cretaceous layers in Chile, and continuing to historical times. It seems that some of the parallel ridges that make up the Cordilleras were not formed at the same time, but were instead raised slowly and successively during different geological periods. The entire range, after sinking twice by several thousand feet, was lifted again through a slow movement during the era of the Eocene tertiary formations, after which it sank down once more by several hundred feet, only to be gradually uplifted to its current elevation through a slow and often interrupted process.252 In part of this later period, the "Pampean mud" was formed, where the Megatherium mylodon and other extinct mammals are found. This mud contains recent types of shells, some of them typical of brackish water, and Mr. Darwin believes it to be a deposit from an estuary or delta. However, M. A. d'Orbigny has proposed a theory referenced by M. E. de Beaumont, suggesting that the disturbances and displacements of the ocean waters caused by the rise of the Andes resulted in a flood, the Pampean mud—sometimes found at elevations of up to 12,000 feet—is thought to be evidence and a remnant of that deluge.253

In studying many chains of mountains, we find that the strike or line of outcrop of continuous sets of strata, and the general direction of the chain, may be far from rectilinear. Curves forming angles of 20° or 30° may be found in the same range as in the Alleghanies; just as trains of active volcanoes and the zones throughout which modern earthquakes occur are often linear, without running in straight lines. Nor are all of these, though contemporaneous or belonging to our own epoch, by any means parallel, but some at right angles, the one to the other.

In studying various mountain ranges, we see that the direction or line of exposure of continuous layers of rock, as well as the overall orientation of the range, can be quite irregular. Curves forming angles of 20° or 30° can exist in the same range, as seen in the Alleghenies; likewise, chains of active volcanoes and the areas where modern earthquakes occur are often linear, even if they don't follow straight lines. Additionally, not all of these features, even if they are from the same time period, are parallel; some may be at right angles to each other.

Slow upheaval and subsidence.—Recent observations have disclosed to us the wonderful fact, that not only the west coast of South America, but also other large areas, some of them several thousand miles in circumference, such as Scandinavia, and certain archipelagoes in the Pacific, are slowly and insensibly rising; while other regions, such as Greenland, and parts of the Pacific and Indian Oceans, in which atolls or circular coral islands abound, are as gradually sinking. That all the existing continents and submarine abysses may have originated in movements of this kind, continued throughout incalculable periods of time, is undeniable, and the denudation which the dry land appears everywhere to have suffered, favors the idea that it was raised from the deep by a succession of upward movements, prolonged throughout indefinite periods. For the action of waves and currents on land slowly emerging from the deep, affords the only power by which we can conceive 171 so many deep valleys and wide spaces to have been denuded as those which are unquestionably the effects of running water.

Slow Upheaval and Subsidence.—Recent observations have revealed an amazing fact: not only is the west coast of South America rising, but also other large areas, some of which are several thousand miles around, like Scandinavia and certain island groups in the Pacific, are slowly and imperceptibly increasing in elevation. Meanwhile, other regions, such as Greenland and parts of the Pacific and Indian Oceans, where atolls or circular coral islands are common, are gradually sinking. It’s undeniable that all existing continents and underwater depths may have resulted from movements of this kind, continuing over unimaginable lengths of time. The erosion that dry land seems to have experienced everywhere supports the idea that it was uplifted from the deep due to a series of upward movements occurring over indefinite stretches of time. The action of waves and currents on land slowly emerging from the depths provides the only force we can conceive of that could account for the numerous deep valleys and wide spaces that have been shaped by the effects of flowing water.

But perhaps it may be said that there is no analogy between the slow upheaval of broad plains or table-lands, and the manner in which we must presume all mountain-chains, with their inclined strata, to have originated. It seems, however, that the Andes have been rising century after century, at the rate of several feet, while the Pampas on the east have been raised only a few inches in the same time. Crossing from the Atlantic to the Pacific, in a line passing through Mendoza, Mr. Darwin traversed a plain 800 miles broad, the eastern part of which has emerged from beneath the sea at a very modern period. The slope from the Atlantic is at first very gentle, then greater, until the traveller finds, on reaching Mendoza, that he has gained, almost insensibly, a height of 4000 feet. The mountainous district then begins suddenly, and its breadth from Mendoza to the shores of the Pacific is 120 miles, the average height of the principal chain being from 15,000 to 16,000 feet, without including some prominent peaks, which ascend much higher. Now all we require, to explain the origin of the principal inequalities of level here described, is to imagine, first, a zone of more violent movement to the west of Mendoza, and, secondly, to the east of that place, an upheaving force, which died away gradually as it approached the Atlantic. In short, we are only called upon to conceive, that the region of the Andes was pushed up four feet in the same period in which the Pampas near Mendoza rose one foot, and the plains near the shores of the Atlantic one inch. In Europe we have learnt that the land at the North Cape ascends about five feet in a century, while farther to the south the movements diminish in quantity first to a foot, and then, at Stockholm, to three inches in a century, while at certain points still farther south there is no movement.

But maybe it's fair to say that there’s no real comparison between the gradual rise of wide plains or plateaus and how we think all mountain ranges, with their sloped layers, came to be. However, it appears that the Andes have been rising century after century at a rate of several feet, while the Pampas to the east have only been lifted a few inches in the same timeframe. When crossing from the Atlantic to the Pacific through Mendoza, Mr. Darwin traveled over a plain that's 800 miles wide, with the eastern part having recently come up from beneath the sea. The slope from the Atlantic starts off very gentle and then steepens, so that by the time the traveler reaches Mendoza, he has almost unconsciously gained an altitude of 4000 feet. Then the mountainous area abruptly begins, stretching 120 miles from Mendoza to the Pacific coast, with the main range averaging between 15,000 and 16,000 feet, not counting some prominent peaks that rise much higher. To explain the main differences in elevation described here, we just need to imagine, first, a zone of more intense movement to the west of Mendoza, and second, an uplifting force to the east that gradually decreased as it approached the Atlantic. In essence, we only need to picture that the Andes rose four feet during the same time that the Pampas near Mendoza rose one foot, and the plains near the Atlantic coast rose just one inch. In Europe, we’ve learned that the land at North Cape rises about five feet in a century, while further south, the movements decrease first to a foot, and then, at Stockholm, to three inches a century, and at some spots even further south, there’s no movement at all.

But in what manner, it is asked, can we account for the great lateral pressure which has been exerted not only in the Andes, Alps, and other chains, but also on the strata of many low and nearly level countries? Do not the folding and fracture of the beds, the anticlinal and synclinal ridges and troughs, as they are called, and the vertical, and even sometimes the inverted position of the beds, imply an abruptness and intensity in the disturbing force wholly different in kind and energy to that which now rends the rocks during ordinary earthquakes? I shall treat more fully in the sequel (end of chap. 32) of the probable subterranean sources, whether of upward or downward movement, and of great lateral pressure; but it may be well briefly to state in this place that in our own times, as, for example, in Chili, in 1822, the volcanic force has overcome the resistance, and permanently uplifted a country of such vast extent that the weight and volume of the Andes must be insignificant in comparison, even if we indulge the most moderate conjectures as to the thickness of the earth's crust above the volcanic foci.

But how can we explain the significant lateral pressure observed not only in the Andes, Alps, and other mountain ranges but also on the layers of many low and nearly flat countries? Do the folding and fracturing of the rock layers, along with the anticlinal and synclinal ridges and troughs, as they are called, and the vertical, and sometimes even inverted, positions of the layers suggest an abruptness and intensity in the disturbing force that is entirely different in nature and strength from what we see during regular earthquakes? I will discuss in more detail later (end of chap. 32) the likely underground sources, whether for upward or downward movement, and for significant lateral pressure; however, it's worth mentioning here that in our times, as seen in Chile in 1822, volcanic forces have overcome resistance and permanently raised a vast area of land, making the weight and volume of the Andes seem insignificant by comparison, even if we consider the most conservative estimates of the thickness of the earth's crust above the volcanic hotspots.

To assume that any set of strata with which we are acquainted are made up of such cohesive and unyielding materials, as to be able to 172 resist a power of such stupendous energy, if its direction, instead of being vertical, happened to be oblique or horizontal, would be extremely rash. But if they could yield to a sideway thrust, even in a slight degree, they would become squeezed and folded to any amount if subjected for a sufficient number of times to the repeated action of the same force. We can scarcely doubt that a mass of rock several miles thick was uplifted in Chili in 1822 and 1835, and that a much greater volume of solid matter is upheaved wherever the rise of the land is very gradual, as in Scandinavia, the development of heat being probably, in that region, at a greater distance from the surface. If continents, rocked, shaken, and fissured, like the western region of South America, or very gently elevated, like Norway and Sweden, do not acquire in a few days or hours an additional height of several thousand feet, this can arise from no lack of mechanical force in the subterranean moving cause, but simply because the antagonist power, or the strength, toughness, and density of the earth's crust is insufficient to resist, so long, as to allow the volcanic energy an indefinite time to accumulate. Instead of the explosive charge augmenting in quantity for countless ages, it finds relief continuously, or by a succession of shocks of moderate violence, so as never to burst or blow up the covering of incumbent rock in one grand paroxysmal convulsion. Even in its most energetic efforts it displays an intermittent and mitigated intensity, being never permitted to lay a whole continent in ruins. Hence the numerous eruptions of lava from the same vent, or chain of vents, and the recurrence of similar earthquakes for thousands of years along certain areas or zones of country. Hence the numerous monuments of the successive ejection and injection of melted matter in ancient geological epochs, and the fissures formed in distinct ages, and often widened and filled at different eras.

To think that any layers of rock we know about are made of such solid and unyielding materials that they could withstand an incredibly powerful force, especially if that force is directed horizontally or at an angle instead of straight down, would be extremely foolish. However, if these layers could bend even slightly under a sideways push, they would become compressed and folded significantly with enough repeated pressure over time. There’s little doubt that a thick mass of rock was pushed upwards in Chile in 1822 and 1835, and an even larger volume of solid material is lifted wherever land rises gradually, like in Scandinavia, where the heat might be located deeper underground. If continents, which are rocked, shaken, and cracked like the western part of South America, or gently elevated like Norway and Sweden, don’t gain several thousand feet of height in just a few days or hours, it’s not due to a shortage of mechanical force coming from underground, but simply because the opposing strength, durability, and density of the Earth’s crust aren’t enough to resist long enough for volcanic energy to build up indefinitely. Instead of the pressure building up for ages until it explodes all at once, it finds relief continuously or through a series of moderate shocks that prevent a massive eruption. Even during its strongest moments, it shows an uneven and reduced intensity, never allowing a whole continent to be completely devastated. This explains the frequent eruptions of lava from the same vent or series of vents and the repeated occurrence of similar earthquakes over thousands of years in certain regions. It also accounts for the many signs of past ejections and injections of molten material from ancient geological times, and the cracks formed in different eras, often widened and filled at various points in history.

Among the causes of lateral pressure, the expansion by heat of large masses of solid stone intervening between others which have a different degree of expansibility, or which happen not to have their temperature raised at the same time, may play an important part. But as we know that rocks have so often sunk down thousands of feet below their original level, we can hardly doubt that much of the bending of pliant strata, and the packing of the same into smaller spaces, has frequently been occasioned by subsidence. Whether the failure of support be produced by the melting of porous rocks, which, when fluid, and subjected to great pressure, may occupy less room than before, or which, by passing from a pasty to a crystalline condition, may, as in the case of granite, according to the experiments of Deville, suffer a contraction of 10 per cent., or whether the sinking be due to the subtraction of lava driven elsewhere to some volcanic orifice, and there forced outwards, or whether it be brought on by the shrinking of solid and stony masses during refrigeration, or by the condensation of gases, or any other imaginable cause, we have no reason to incline to the idea that the consequent geological changes are brought about so suddenly, as 173 that large parts of continents are swallowed up at once in unfathomable subterranean abysses. If cavities be formed, they will be enlarged gradually, and as gradually filled. We read, indeed, accounts of engulphed cities and areas of limited extent which have sunk down many yards at once; but we have as yet no authentic records of the sudden disappearance of mountains, or the submergence or emergence of great islands. On the other hand, the creeps in coal mines254 demonstrate that gravitation begins to act as soon as a moderate quantity of matter is removed even at a great depth. The roof sinks in, or the floor of the mine rises, and the bent strata often assume as regularly a curved and crumpled arrangement as that observed on a grander scale in mountain-chains. The absence, indeed, of chaotic disorder, and the regularity of the plications in geological formations of high antiquity, although not unfrequently adduced to prove the unity and instantaneousness of the disturbing force, might with far greater propriety be brought forward as an argument in favor of the successive application of some irresistible but moderated force, such as that which can elevate or depress a continent.

Among the causes of lateral pressure, the expansion from heat of large solid stone masses that are surrounded by others with different levels of expandability, or those that haven't had their temperature raised at the same time, can play a significant role. However, since we know that rocks have often sunk thousands of feet below their original level, it's hard to doubt that much of the bending of flexible layers and the compression of these layers into smaller spaces has often been caused by subsidence. Whether the loss of support comes from the melting of porous rocks, which, when fluid and under great pressure, might take up less space than before, or from transitioning from a pasty to a crystalline state—like granite, which, according to Deville's experiments, can contract up to 10 percent—or whether the sinking happens due to lava being channeled elsewhere to some volcanic vent and then forced outwards, or whether it results from the shrinking of solid stone masses during cooling, the condensation of gases, or any other conceivable cause, we have no reason to think that the resulting geological changes happen so suddenly that large areas of continents are just swallowed up into endless underground abysses. If cavities form, they will be enlarged gradually and filled at the same pace. We do read stories of engulfed cities and limited areas that have sunk many yards at once, but we have yet to see credible accounts of mountains suddenly disappearing or of large islands submerging or emerging. On the other hand, the collapses in coal mines demonstrate that gravity starts to act as soon as a moderate amount of material is removed, even from a significant depth. The roof caves in, or the floor of the mine rises, and the bent layers often take on a regular curved and crumpled arrangement, similar to what is observed on a larger scale in mountain ranges. Indeed, the lack of chaotic disorder and the regularity of the folds in ancient geological formations, although often used to argue for the unity and immediacy of the disturbing force, could much more appropriately be presented as evidence for the gradual application of some unstoppable but moderated force, such as that which can elevate or lower a continent.

In conclusion, I may observe that one of the soundest objections to the theory of the sudden upthrow or downthrow of mountain-chains is this, that it provides us with too much force of one kind, namely, that of subterranean movement, while it deprives us of another kind of mechanical force, namely, that exerted by the waves and currents of the ocean, which the geologist requires for the denudation of land during its slow upheaval or depression. It may be safely affirmed that the quantity of igneous and aqueous action,—of volcanic eruption and denudation,—of subterranean movement and sedimentary deposition,—not only of past ages, but of one geological epoch, or even the fraction of an epoch, has exceeded immeasurably all the fluctuations of the inorganic world which have been witnessed by man. But we have still to inquire whether the time to which each chapter or page or paragraph of the earth's autobiography relates, was not equally immense when contrasted with a brief era of 3000 or 5000 years. The real point on which the whole controversy turns, is the relative amount of work done by mechanical force in given quantities of time, past and present. Before we can determine the relative intensity of the force employed, we must have some fixed standard by which to measure the time expended in its development at two distinct periods. It is not the magnitude of the effects, however gigantic their proportions, which can inform us in the slightest degree whether the operation was sudden or gradual, insensible or paroxysmal. It must be shown that a slow process could never in any series of ages give rise to the same results.

In conclusion, I can point out that one of the strongest objections to the theory of sudden uplift or sinking of mountain ranges is that it relies too much on one type of force—subterranean movement—while overlooking another essential type of mechanical force, which is the impact of ocean waves and currents. This is necessary for understanding how land erodes during its gradual rise or fall. It's safe to say that the amount of volcanic and water-related activity—like eruptions and erosion, underground movement, and the accumulation of sediment—not only from ancient times but also from a single geological period, or even a fraction of a period, far surpasses all the changes in the inorganic world that humans have observed. However, we still need to explore whether the timeframe related to each chapter, page, or paragraph of the Earth’s history was also incredibly vast when compared to a short period of 3,000 or 5,000 years. The key question in this debate is the relative amount of work done by mechanical force over specific timeframes, both past and present. Before we can assess the relative strength of the forces at play, we need a clear standard to measure the time spent on their development during two separate periods. It's not the enormity of the effects, no matter how gigantic they are, that can tell us whether the process was sudden or gradual, subtle or explosive. It must be demonstrated that a slow process could never produce the same results over any series of ages.

The advocate of paroxysmal energy might assume a uniform and fixed rate of variation in times past and present for the animate world, that is to say, for the dying-out and coming-in of species, and then endeavor 174 to prove that the changes of the inanimate world have not gone on in a corresponding ratio. But the adoption of such a standard of comparison would lead, I suspect, to a theory by no means favorable to the pristine intensity of natural causes. That the present state of the organic world is not stationary, can be fairly inferred from the fact, that some species are known to have become extinct in the course even of the last three centuries, and that the exterminating causes always in activity, both on the land and in the waters, are very numerous; also, because man himself is an extremely modern creation; and we may therefore reasonably suppose that some of the mammalia now contemporary with man, as well as a variety of species of inferior classes, may have been recently introduced into the earth, to supply the places of plants and animals which have from time to time disappeared. But granting that some such secular variation in the zoological and botanical worlds is going on, and is by no means wholly inappreciable to the naturalist, still it is certainly far less manifest than the revolution always in progress in the inorganic world. Every year some volcanic eruptions take place, and a rude estimate might be made of the number of cubic feet of lava and scoriæ poured or cast out of various craters. The amount of mud and sand deposited in deltas, and the advance of new land upon the sea, or the annual retreat of wasting sea-cliffs, are changes the minimum amount of which might be roughly estimated. The quantity of land raised above or depressed below the level of the sea might also be computed, and the change arising from such movements in a century might be conjectured. Suppose the average rise of the land in some parts of Scandinavia to be as much as five feet in a hundred years, the present sea-coast might be uplifted 700 feet in fourteen thousand years; but we should have no reason to anticipate, from any zoological data hitherto acquired, that the molluscous fauna of the northern seas would in that lapse of years undergo any sensible amount of variation. We discover sea-beaches in Norway 700 feet high, in which the shells are identical with those now inhabiting the German Ocean; for the rise of land in Scandinavia, however insensible to the inhabitants, has evidently been rapid when compared to the rate of contemporaneous change in the testaceous fauna of the German Ocean. Were we to wait therefore until the mollusca shall have undergone as much fluctuation as they underwent between the period of the Lias and the Upper Oolite formations; or between the Oolite and Chalk, nay, even between any two of eight subdivisions of the Eocene series, what stupendous revolutions in physical geography ought we not to expect, and how many mountain-chains might not be produced by the repetition of shocks of moderate violence, or by movements not even perceptible by man!

The supporter of sudden energy might think that there has been a consistent and fixed rate of change in both past and present for living beings, meaning for the extinction and emergence of species, and then try to show that the changes in the non-living world haven't happened at the same rate. But using such a standard for comparison would likely lead to a theory that doesn't favor the original power of natural causes. The fact that the current state of the organic world is not stable can be reasonably inferred from the existence of some species that have gone extinct in just the last three centuries, and the many ongoing exterminating causes, both on land and in water; also, since humans are a very recent creation, we can assume that some of the mammals currently living alongside humans, as well as various species of lower classifications, may have recently been introduced to replace plants and animals that have disappeared over time. However, assuming that such long-term changes are occurring in the animal and plant worlds, and that these changes are noticeable to naturalists, it's still evident that they are far less obvious than the constant changes happening in the non-living world. Each year, there are volcanic eruptions, and we could make a rough estimate of the volume of lava and ash emitted from different craters. The amount of mud and sand deposited in deltas, the creation of new land from the sea, or the yearly retreat of eroding sea cliffs are changes that can be estimated at a minimum. We could also measure the amount of land that has been raised or lowered relative to sea level, and guess the extent of those changes over a century. If we assume the average increase in land height in some parts of Scandinavia is about five feet every hundred years, the current coastline could be raised 700 feet over fourteen thousand years; however, based on any existing zoological data, we wouldn't expect any significant change in the mollusk population of the northern seas over that period. We find coastal beaches in Norway that are 700 feet high, where the shells are the same as those currently living in the North Sea; the rise of land in Scandinavia, while hardly noticeable to the people living there, has clearly been fast compared to the rate of change in the shellfish fauna of the North Sea. So if we waited until mollusks experienced as much change as they did during the period between the Lias and Upper Oolite formations, or between the Oolite and Chalk, or even between any two of the eight divisions of the Eocene series, what enormous changes in physical geography should we expect, and how many mountain ranges might be formed by repeated moderate shocks or movements that are not even perceptible to humans!

Or, if we turn from the mollusca to the vegetable kingdom, and ask the botanist how many earthquakes and volcanic eruptions might be expected, and how much the relative level of land and sea might be altered, or how far the principal deltas will encroach upon the ocean, or the sea-cliffs recede from the present shores, before the species of 175 European forest-trees will die out, he would reply that such alterations in the inanimate world might be multiplied indefinitely before he should have reason to anticipate, by reference to any known data, that the existing species of trees in our forests would disappear and give place to others. In a word, the movement of the inorganic world is obvious and palpable, and might be likened to the minute-hand of a clock, the progress of which can be seen and heard, whereas the fluctuations of the living creation are nearly invisible, and resemble the motion of the hour-hand of a timepiece. It is only by watching it attentively for some time, and comparing its relative position after an interval, that we can prove the reality of its motion.255

Or, if we shift our focus from mollusks to the plant kingdom and ask a botanist how many earthquakes and volcanic eruptions could be expected, how much the relative levels of land and sea might change, how far the major deltas might advance into the ocean, or how much the sea cliffs might retreat from their current positions before the species of 175 European forest trees go extinct, they would say that such changes in the non-living world could happen indefinitely before they would have any reason to believe, based on known data, that the current species of trees in our forests would vanish to make way for others. In short, the movements of the inorganic world are clear and noticeable, similar to the minute hand of a clock, which can be seen and heard, while the changes in living organisms are nearly invisible and resemble the motion of the hour hand of a clock. We only realize its movement by observing it closely over time and comparing its position after a while. 255


CHAPTER XII

DIFFERENCE IN TEXTURE OF THE OLDER AND NEWER ROCKS.

Consolidation of fossiliferous strata—Some deposits originally solid—Transition and slaty texture—Crystalline character of Plutonic and Metamorphic rocks—Theory of their origin—Essentially subterranean—No proofs that they were produced more abundantly at remote periods.

Consolidation of fossil-containing layers—Some deposits that were originally solid—Transitional and layered texture—Crystalline nature of igneous and metamorphic rocks—Theory of how they formed—Essentially underground—No evidence that they were formed more abundantly in earlier periods.

Another argument in favor of the dissimilarity of the causes operating at remote and recent eras has been derived by many geologists from the more compact, stony, and crystalline texture of the older as compared with the newer rocks.

Another argument supporting the differences in the causes at remote and recent times has been made by many geologists based on the more compact, stony, and crystalline texture of older rocks compared to newer ones.

Consolidation of strata.—This subject may be considered, first in reference to the fossiliferous strata; and, secondly, in reference to those crystalline and stratified rocks which contain no organic remains, such as gneiss and mica-schist. There can be no doubt that the former of these classes, or the fossiliferous, are generally more compact and stony in proportion as they are more ancient. It is also certain that a great part of them were originally in a soft and incoherent state, and that they have been since consolidated. Thus we find occasionally that shingle and sand have been agglutinated firmly together by a ferruginous or siliceous cement, or that lime in solution has been introduced, so as to bind together materials previously incoherent. Organic remains have sometimes suffered a singular transformation, as for 176 example, where shells, corals, and wood are silicified, their calcareous or ligneous matter having been replaced by nearly pure silica. The constituents of some beds have probably set and become hard for the first time when they emerged from beneath the water.

Consolidation of strata.—This topic can be looked at first with respect to the fossil-rich layers, and second regarding the crystalline and layered rocks that don't have any organic remains, like gneiss and mica-schist. It's clear that the fossil-rich layers tend to be more solid and stony the older they are. Furthermore, much of these layers were initially in a soft and loose state before they became compacted. We sometimes see that gravel and sand have been tightly bonded together by a iron-rich or silicate cement, or that dissolved lime has been introduced to hold together previously loose materials. Organic remains have sometimes undergone a unique transformation, for 176 example, where shells, corals, and wood have turned into silica, their calcium or fibrous matter replaced by nearly pure silica. The materials in some layers likely set and hardened for the first time when they came out from under the water.

But, on the other hand, we observe in certain formations now in progress, particularly in coral reefs, and in deposits from the waters of mineral springs, both calcareous and siliceous, that the texture of rocks may sometimes be stony from the first. This circumstance may account for exceptions to the general rule, not unfrequently met with, where solid strata are superimposed on others of a plastic and incoherent nature, as in the neighborhood of Paris, where the tertiary formations, consisting often of compact limestone and siliceous grit, are more stony than the subjacent chalk.

But, on the other hand, we see in certain formations happening right now, especially in coral reefs and in deposits from mineral spring waters, both calcareous and siliceous, that the texture of rocks can sometimes be solid from the start. This might explain the exceptions to the general rule we often encounter, where solid layers are placed on top of others that are soft and disorganized, like in the area around Paris, where the tertiary formations, often made up of dense limestone and siliceous grit, are sturdier than the underlying chalk.

It will readily be understood, that the various solidifying causes, including those above enumerated, together with the pressure of incumbent rocks and the influence of subterranean heat, must all of them require time in order to exert their full power. If in the course of ages they modify the aspect and internal structure of stratified deposits, they will give rise to a general distinctness of character in the older as contrasted with the newer formations. But this distinctness will not be the consequence of any original diversity; they will be unlike, just as the wood in the older trees of a forest usually differs in texture and hardness from that of younger individuals of the same species.

It’s easy to understand that the different solidifying factors, including those mentioned above, along with the pressure from overlying rocks and the effects of underground heat, all need time to fully take effect. Over the ages, if they change the appearance and internal structure of layered deposits, they will create a clear distinction between older and newer formations. However, this distinction won’t come from any initial differences; they will be different in the same way that the wood in older trees in a forest typically has a different texture and hardness compared to younger trees of the same species.

Transition texture.—In the original classification, of Werner, the highly crystalline rocks, such as granite and gneiss, which contain no organic remains, were called primary, and the fossiliferous strata secondary, while to another class of an age intermediate between the primary and secondary he gave the name of transition. They were termed transition because they partook in some degree in their mineral composition of the nature of the most crystalline rocks, such as gneiss and mica-schist, while they resembled the fossiliferous series in containing occasionally organic remains, and exhibiting evident signs of a mechanical origin. It was at first imagined, that the rocks having this intermediate texture had been all deposited subsequently to the series called primary, and before all the more earthy and fossiliferous formations. But when the relative position and organic remains of these transition rocks were better understood, it was perceived that they did not all belong to one period. On the contrary, the same mineral characters were found in strata of very different ages, and some formations occurring in the Alps, which several of the ablest scholars of Werner had determined to be transition, were ultimately ascertained, by means of their fossil contents and position, to be members of the Cretaceous, and even of the nummulitic or Eocene period. These strata had, in fact, acquired the transition texture from the influence of causes which, since their deposition had modified their internal arrangement.

Transition texture.—In Werner's original classification, highly crystalline rocks like granite and gneiss, which don’t contain any organic material, were called primary, while the fossil-bearing layers were labeled secondary. He introduced the term "transition" for another class of rocks that had an age between the primary and secondary. They were called transition because their mineral makeup was somewhat similar to the most crystalline rocks like gneiss and mica-schist, but they also resembled the fossil-bearing layers by occasionally containing organic remains and showing clear signs of a mechanical origin. Initially, it was thought that rocks with this intermediate texture were deposited after the primary series and before the more earthy, fossil-rich formations. However, as the relationship and organic remains of these transition rocks were better understood, it became clear that they didn’t all belong to the same time period. In fact, the same mineral characteristics were found in layers of very different ages, and some formations in the Alps, which several of Werner's top scholars had classified as transition, were later identified by their fossil content and position as members of the Cretaceous and even the nummulitic or Eocene periods. These layers had, in fact, developed the transition texture due to influences that had modified their internal structure since their deposition.

Texture and origin of Plutonic and metamorphic rocks.—Among the most singular of the changes superinduced on rocks, we have occasionally 177 to include the slaty texture, the divisional planes of which sometimes intersect the true planes of stratification, and even pass directly through imbedded fossils. If, then, the crystalline, the slaty, and other modes of arrangement, once deemed characteristic of certain periods in the history of the earth, have in reality been assumed by fossiliferous rocks of different ages and at different times, we are prepared to inquire whether the same may not be true of the most highly crystalline state, such as that of gneiss, mica-schist, and statuary marble. That the peculiar characteristics of such rocks are really due to a variety of modifying causes has long been suspected by many geologists, and the doctrine has gained ground of late, although a considerable difference of opinion still prevails. According to the original Neptunian theory, all the crystalline formations were precipitated from a universal menstruum or chaotic fluid antecedently to the creation of animals and plants, the unstratified granite having been first thrown down so as to serve as a floor or foundation on which gneiss and other stratified rocks might repose. Afterwards, when the igneous origin of granite was no longer disputed, many conceived that a thermal ocean enveloped the globe, at a time when the first-formed crust of granite was cooling, but when it still retained much of its heat. The hot waters of this ocean held in solution the ingredients of gneiss, mica-schist, hornblende-schist, clay-slate, and marble, rocks which were precipitated, one after the other, in a crystalline form. No fossils could be inclosed in them, the high temperature of the fluid and the quantity of mineral matter which it held in solution, rendering it unfit for the support of organic beings.

Texture and origin of Plutonic and metamorphic rocks.—Among the most unique changes that occur in rocks, we sometimes find the slaty texture, where the division lines can intersect the actual layers of stratification and even go right through embedded fossils. If the crystalline, slaty, and other arrangements, once thought to be characteristic of specific periods in Earth's history, have actually been taken on by fossil-rich rocks of various ages and times, we should consider whether the same might be true for highly crystalline forms like gneiss, mica-schist, and statuary marble. Many geologists have long suspected that the distinct characteristics of these rocks arise from various modifying factors, and this idea has gained traction recently, though there's still a significant difference of opinion on the matter. According to the original Neptunian theory, all crystalline formations were deposited from a universal solvent or chaotic fluid before the creation of animals and plants, with unstratified granite being laid down first to serve as the foundation upon which gneiss and other stratified rocks could rest. Later, when the igneous nature of granite became undisputed, many believed that a thermal ocean surrounded the Earth when the initial granite crust was cooling but still retained a lot of heat. The hot waters of this ocean dissolved the ingredients needed to form gneiss, mica-schist, hornblende-schist, clay-slate, and marble, which were precipitated one after another in a crystalline form. No fossils could be included in these rocks since the high temperature of the fluid and its dissolved mineral content made it unsuitable for supporting organic life.

It would be inconsistent with the plan of this work to enter here into a detailed account of what I have elsewhere termed the metamorphic theory;256 but I may state that it is now demonstrable in some countries that fossiliferous formations, some of them of the age of the Silurian strata, as near Christiana in Norway, others belonging to the Oolitic period, as around Carrara in Italy, have been converted partially into gneiss, mica-schist, and statuary marble. The transmutation has been effected apparently by the influence of subterranean heat, acting under great pressure, or by chemical and electrical causes operating in a manner not yet understood, and which have been termed Plutonic action, as expressing, in one word, all the modifying causes which may be brought into play at great depths, and under conditions never exemplified at the surface. To this Plutonic action the fusion of granite itself in the bowels of the earth, as well as the superinducement of the metamorphic texture into sedimentary strata, must be attributed; and in accordance with these views the age of each metamorphic formation may be said to be twofold, for we have first to consider the period when it originated, as an aqueous deposit, in the form of mud, sand, marl, or limestone; secondly, the date at which it acquired a crystalline 178 texture. The same strata, therefore, may, according to this view, be very ancient in reference to the time of their deposition, and very modern in regard to the period of their assuming the metamorphic character.

It wouldn't align with the purpose of this work to go into a detailed explanation of what I've previously called the metamorphic theory;256 but I can mention that in some countries, it's now proven that fossil-bearing formations—some dating back to the Silurian period, like those near Christiana in Norway, and others from the Oolitic period, such as around Carrara in Italy—have partially transformed into gneiss, mica-schist, and statuary marble. This transformation seems to have occurred due to the effects of underground heat working under high pressure, or through chemical and electrical processes that are not yet fully understood, which are collectively referred to as Plutonic action. This term encapsulates all the modifying factors that can take place at great depths and under conditions not seen at the surface. To this Plutonic action, we must attribute the melting of granite deep within the Earth, as well as the development of metamorphic textures in sedimentary layers. According to these ideas, each metamorphic formation has two ages: first, the time when it formed as a sedimentary deposit of mud, sand, marl, or limestone; and second, the time it developed a crystalline 178 texture. Thus, these same layers can be considered very old in terms of their deposition and very recent regarding when they took on their metamorphic qualities.

No proofs that these crystalline rocks were produced more abundantly at remote periods.—Several modern writers, without denying the truth of the Plutonic or metamorphic theory, still contend that the crystalline and non-fossiliferous formations, whether stratified or unstratified, such as gneiss and granite, are essentially ancient as a class of rocks. They were generated, say they, most abundantly in the primeval state of the globe, since which time the quantity produced has been always on the decrease, until it became very inconsiderable in the Oolitic and Cretaceous periods, and quite evanescent before the commencement of the tertiary epoch.

No evidence that these crystalline rocks were formed more frequently in the distant past.—Several modern authors, while not disputing the validity of the Plutonic or metamorphic theory, argue that crystalline and non-fossil-bearing formations, whether layered or unlayered, like gneiss and granite, are fundamentally ancient types of rocks. They suggest that these rocks were produced in the greatest quantity during the early stages of the Earth's history, and that the amount produced has steadily decreased over time, becoming quite minimal during the Oolitic and Cretaceous periods, and nearly nonexistent before the start of the tertiary period.

Now the justness of these views depends almost entirely on the question whether granite, gneiss, and other rocks of the same order ever originated at the surface, or whether, according to the opinions above adopted, they are essentially subterranean in their origin, and therefore entitled to the appellation of hypogene. If they were formed superficially in their present state, and as copiously in the modern as in the more ancient periods, we ought to see a greater abundance of tertiary and secondary than of primary granite and gneiss; but if we adopt the hypogene theory before explained, their rapid diminution in volume among the visible rocks in the earth's crust in proportion as we investigate the formations of newer date, is quite intelligible. If a melted mass of matter be now cooling very slowly at the depth of several miles beneath the crater of an active volcano, it must remain invisible until great revolutions in the earth's crust have been brought about. So also if stratified rocks have been subjected to Plutonic action, and after having been baked or reduced to semi-fusion, are now cooling and crystallizing far under ground, it will probably require the lapse of many periods before they will be forced up to the surface and exposed to view, even at a single point. To effect this purpose there may be need of as great a development of subterranean movement as that which in the Alps, Andes, and Himalaya has raised marine strata containing ammonites to the height of 8000, 14,000, and 16,000 feet. By parity of reasoning we can hardly expect that any hypogene rocks of the tertiary periods will have been brought within the reach of human observation, seeing that the emergence of such rocks must always be so long posterior to the date of their origin, and still less can formations of this class become generally visible until so much time has elapsed as to confer on them a high relative antiquity. Extensive denudation must also combine with upheaval before they can be displayed at the surface throughout wide areas.

The accuracy of these views mainly depends on whether granite, gneiss, and similar rocks were formed at the surface or, according to the opinions mentioned earlier, if they are primarily underground in origin, thus deserving the term hypogene. If they were formed on the surface in their current state, and as abundantly today as in the past, we should see more tertiary and secondary granite and gneiss than primary. However, if we accept the previously explained hypogene theory, their rapid decrease in volume among the observable rocks in the earth's crust, as we study newer formations, makes sense. If a melted mass of material is now slowly cooling several miles beneath the crater of an active volcano, it will remain hidden until significant changes occur in the earth's crust. Similarly, if layered rocks have been influenced by Plutonic activity and have been baked or partially melted before cooling and crystallizing deep underground, it may take a long time for them to be pushed to the surface and revealed, even in small areas. Achieving this might require as much subterranean movement as that which has lifted marine layers containing ammonites to heights of 8,000, 14,000, and 16,000 feet in the Alps, Andes, and Himalayas. Following this logic, it’s unlikely that any hypogene rocks from the tertiary periods will be accessible for observation since their emergence will always occur long after they were formed, and it’s even less likely for formations of this type to become widely visible until significant time has passed to give them considerable age. Extensive erosion must also occur in conjunction with uplift before they can be exposed at the surface over large areas.

All geologists who reflect on subterranean movements now going on, and the eruptions of active volcanoes, are convinced that great changes are now continually in progress in the interior of the earth's crust far out 179 of sight. They must be conscious, therefore, that the inaccessibility of the regions in which these alterations are taking place, compels them to remain in ignorance of a great part of the working of existing causes, so that they can only form vague conjectures in regard to the nature of the products which volcanic heat may elaborate under great pressure.

All geologists who think about the underground movements happening now, and the eruptions of active volcanoes, are convinced that significant changes are continually taking place deep within the earth's crust, far out of sight. They must realize that the inaccessibility of the areas where these changes occur keeps them unaware of much of the operations of current causes, leading them to form only vague guesses about the kinds of materials volcanic heat might produce under extreme pressure.

But when they find in mountain-chains of high antiquity, that what was once the interior of the earth's crust has since been forced outwards and exposed to view, they will naturally expect in the examination of those mountainous regions, to have an opportunity of gratifying their curiosity by obtaining a sight not only of the superficial strata of remote eras, but also of the contemporaneous nether-formed rocks. Having recognized, therefore, in such mountain-chains some ancient rocks of aqueous and volcanic origin, corresponding in character to superficial formations of modern date, they will regard any other class of ancient rocks, such as granite and gneiss, as the residual phenomena of which they are in search. These latter rocks will not answer the expectations previously formed of their probable nature and texture, unless they wear a foreign and mysterious aspect, and have in some places been fused or altered by subterranean heat; in a word, unless they differ wholly from the fossiliferous strata deposited at the surface, or from the lava and scoriæ thrown out by volcanoes in the open air. It is the total distinctness, therefore, of crystalline formations, such as granite, hornblende-schist, and the rest, from every substance of which the origin is familiar to us, that constitutes their claim to be regarded as the effects of causes now in action in the subterranean regions. They belong not to an order of things which has passed away; they are not the monuments of a primeval period, bearing inscribed upon them in obsolete characters the words and phrases of a dead language; but they teach us that part of the living language of nature, which we cannot learn by our daily intercourse with what passes on the habitable surface.

But when they discover in ancient mountain ranges that what was once deep within the earth's crust has been pushed outward and exposed, they will naturally expect to satisfy their curiosity by examining those mountainous areas, not only to see the surface layers from long ago but also the rocks formed below at the same time. Having identified, then, in these mountain chains some ancient rocks of water and volcanic origin, similar to the more recent surface formations, they will consider any other type of ancient rocks, like granite and gneiss, as the residual phenomena they are looking for. These latter rocks won't meet the expectations formed about their likely nature and texture unless they have an unfamiliar and enigmatic appearance and have been altered or melted in places by underground heat; in other words, unless they are completely different from the fossil-rich layers found at the surface or the lava and ash ejected by open-air volcanoes. It is this complete distinctiveness of crystalline formations, such as granite, hornblende-schist, and others, from any substance we know that justifies viewing them as the results of processes still happening in the depths of the earth. They do not belong to a bygone era; they are not monuments of a primitive time, inscribed with the words and phrases of a language long dead; rather, they teach us part of the living language of nature that we cannot learn through our daily interactions with what occurs on the habitable surface.


CHAPTER XIII

UNIFORMITY IN THE SERIES OF PAST CHANGES IN THE ANIMATE AND INANIMATE WORLD.

Supposed alternate periods of repose and disorder—Observed facts in which this doctrine has originated—These may be explained by supposing a uniform and uninterrupted series of changes—Threefold consideration of this subject; first, in reference to the living creation, extinction of species, and origin of new animals and plants; secondly, in reference to the changes produced in the earth's crust by the continuance of subterranean movements in certain areas, and their transference after long periods to new areas; thirdly, in reference to the laws which govern the formation of fossiliferous strata, and the shifting of the areas of sedimentary deposition—On the combined influence of all these modes and causes of change in producing breaks and chasms in the chain of records—Concluding remarks on the identity of the ancient and present system of terrestrial changes.

Supposed alternating periods of rest and chaos—Observed facts that led to this theory—These can be explained by imagining a consistent and ongoing series of changes—A threefold view of this topic: first, regarding living organisms, the extinction of species, and the emergence of new animals and plants; second, concerning the changes in the Earth's crust caused by the ongoing underground movements in certain regions, and their eventual shift to new areas after long periods; third, looking at the laws governing the formation of fossil-containing layers and the movement of areas where sediment is deposited—On the combined effect of all these factors in creating gaps and breaks in the record—Final thoughts on the continuity between ancient and modern terrestrial changes.

Origin of the doctrine of alternate periods of repose and disorder.—It has been truly observed, that when we arrange the fossiliferous formations in chronological order, they constitute a broken and defective series of monuments: we pass without any intermediate gradations, from systems of strata which are horizontal to other systems which are highly inclined, from rocks of peculiar mineral composition to others which have a character wholly distinct,—from one assemblage of organic remains to another, in which frequently all the species, and most of the genera, are different. These violations of continuity are so common, as to constitute the rule rather than the exception, and they have been considered by many geologists as conclusive in favor of sudden revolutions in the inanimate and animate world. According to the speculations of some writers, there have been in the past history of the planet alternate periods of tranquillity and convulsion, the former enduring for ages, and resembling that state of things now experienced by man: the other brief, transient, and paroxysmal, giving rise to new mountains, seas, and valleys, annihilating one set of organic beings, and ushering in the creation of another.

Origin of the doctrine of alternate periods of rest and chaos.—It has been accurately noted that when we organize fossil-bearing formations in chronological order, they form a fragmented and incomplete series of records: we move without any intermediate transitions from layers of rock that are horizontal to those that are steeply tilted, from rocks with specific mineral compositions to others that are entirely different,—from one collection of fossil remains to another, in which often all the species and most of the genera differ. These breaks in continuity are so prevalent that they are the norm rather than the exception, and many geologists have viewed them as strong evidence of sudden changes in both the non-living and living world. According to the theories of some authors, there have been alternating periods of calm and upheaval throughout the Earth's history, with the former lasting for long ages, similar to the current state of human experience; the latter being brief, sudden, and intense, leading to the formation of new mountains, seas, and valleys, wiping out one group of living organisms and bringing forth the emergence of another.

It will be the object of the present chapter to demonstrate, that these theoretical views are not borne out by a fair interpretation of geological monuments. It is true that in the solid framework of the globe, we have a chronological chain of natural records, and that many links in this chain are wanting; but a careful consideration of all the phenomena will lead to the opinion that the series was originally defective,—that it has been rendered still more so by time—that a great part of what remains is inaccessible to man, and even of that fraction which is accessible, nine-tenths are to this day unexplored.

The goal of this chapter is to show that these theoretical ideas aren’t supported by a fair interpretation of geological evidence. It's true that within the Earth's solid structure, we have a chronological series of natural records, and many parts of this series are missing. However, a careful look at all the evidence suggests that the series was originally incomplete, and time has made it even more so. A significant portion of what remains is out of reach for humans, and of the portion that is accessible, ninety percent is still unexplored.

How the facts may be explained by assuming a uniform series of changes.—The readiest way, perhaps, of persuading the reader that we 181 may dispense with great and sudden revolutions in the geological order of events, is by showing him how a regular and uninterrupted series of changes in the animate and inanimate world may give rise to such breaks in the sequence, and such unconformability of stratified rocks, as are usually thought to imply convulsions and catastrophes. It is scarcely necessary to state, that the order of events thus assumed to occur, for the sake of illustration, must be in harmony with all the conclusions legitimately drawn by geologists from the structure of the earth, and must be equally in accordance with the changes observed by man to be now going on in the living as well as in the inorganic creation. It may be necessary in the present state of science to supply some part of the assumed course of nature hypothetically; but if so, this must be done without any violation of probability, and always consistently with the analogy of what is known both of the past and present economy of our system. Although the discussion of so comprehensive a subject must carry the beginner far beyond his depth, it will also, it is hoped, stimulate his curiosity, and prepare him to read some elementary treatises on geology with advantage, and teach him the bearing on that science of the changes now in progress on the earth. At the same time it may enable him the better to understand the intimate connection between the second and third books of this work, the former of which is occupied with the changes in the inorganic, the latter with those of the organic creation.

How the facts can be explained by assuming a consistent series of changes.—The easiest way to convince the reader that we 181 can do without major and sudden upheavals in the geological timeline is by demonstrating how a steady and continuous series of changes in both living and non-living things can lead to such disruptions in the sequence, and such inconsistencies in stratified rocks, which are typically thought to indicate violent events and disasters. It's almost unnecessary to mention that the order of events we assume for illustration purposes must align with all the conclusions drawn legitimately by geologists from the earth's structure, and must also be consistent with the changes observed by humans that are currently occurring in both living and non-living nature. It may be required, given our current understanding of science, to hypothesize some aspects of the assumed natural course; but if so, this must be done without breaching any sense of probability, and must always align with the analogy of what we know from both the past and present workings of our system. While discussing such a wide-ranging topic may overwhelm the beginner, it is also hoped that it will spark their curiosity and prepare them to read some basic texts on geology with benefit, and teach them how the changes happening on Earth relate to that science. At the same time, it may help them better understand the close connection between the second and third books of this work, the first of which focuses on changes in the inorganic world, and the second on those in the organic world.

In pursuance, then, of the plan above proposed, I shall consider in this chapter, first, what may be the course of fluctuation in the animate world; secondly, the mode in which contemporaneous subterranean movements affect the earth's crust; and, thirdly, the laws which regulate the deposition of sediment.

In line with the plan mentioned earlier, I will discuss in this chapter, first, the possible patterns of fluctuation in the living world; second, how current underground movements impact the earth's crust; and third, the laws that govern sediment deposition.

UNIFORMITY OF CHANGE CONSIDERED FIRST IN REFERENCE TO THE LIVING CREATION.

First, in regard to the vicissitudes of the living creation, all are agreed that the sedimentary strata found in the earth's crust are divisible into a variety of groups, more or less dissimilar in their organic remains and mineral composition. The conclusion universally drawn from the study and comparison of these fossiliferous groups is this, that at successive periods distinct tribes of animals and plants have inhabited the land and waters, and that the organic types of the newer formations are more analogous to species now existing, than those of more ancient rocks. If we then turn to the present state of the animate creation, and inquire whether it has now become fixed and stationary, we discover that, on the contrary, it is in a state of continual flux—that there are many causes in action which tend to the extinction of species, and which are conclusive against the doctrine of their unlimited durability. But natural history has been successfully cultivated for so short a period, that a few examples only of local, and perhaps but one or two of absolute, extirpation 182 can as yet be proved, and these only where the interference of man has been conspicuous. It will nevertheless appear evident, from the facts and arguments detailed in the third book (from the thirty-seventh to the forty-second chapters, inclusive) that man is not the only exterminating agent; and that, independently of his intervention, the annihilation of species is promoted by the multiplication and gradual diffusion of every animal or plant. It will also appear, that every alteration in the physical geography and climate of the globe cannot fail to have the same tendency. If we proceed still farther, and inquire whether new species are substituted from time to time for those which die out, and whether there are certain laws appointed by the Author of Nature to regulate such new creations, we find that the period of human observation is as yet too short to afford data for determining so weighty a question. All that can be done is to show that the successive introduction of new species may be a constant part of the economy of the terrestrial system, without our having any right to expect that we should be in possession of direct proof of the fact. The appearance again and again of new species may easily have escaped detection, since the numbers of known animals and plants have augmented so rapidly within the memory of persons now living, as to have doubled in some classes, and quadrupled in others. It will also be remarked in the sequel (book iii. chap. 43), that it must always be more easy if species proceeded originally from single stocks, to prove that one which formerly abounded in a given district has ceased to be, than that another has been called into being for the first time. If, therefore, there be as yet only one or two unequivocal instances of extinction, namely, those of the dodo and solitaire (see ch. 41), it is scarcely reasonable as yet to hope that we should be cognizant of a single instance of the first appearance of a new species.

First, regarding the changes in living things, everyone agrees that the sedimentary layers found in the Earth’s crust can be divided into various groups, which differ in their organic remains and mineral composition. The general conclusion drawn from studying and comparing these fossilized groups is that, across different periods, distinct types of animals and plants have lived on land and in water, and that the organic types in newer formations are more similar to species that exist today than those found in older rocks. If we then look at the current state of living organisms and ask whether it has become fixed and unchanging, we find that, on the contrary, it is in a state of constant change—that there are many factors at work that lead to the extinction of species, which contradicts the idea of their unlimited durability. However, natural history has only been actively studied for a relatively short time, so we can only prove a few examples of local extinction, and perhaps just one or two absolute extinctions, and these mainly where human interference is evident. Nevertheless, from the facts and arguments presented in the third book (from the thirty-seventh to the forty-second chapters, inclusive), it will be clear that humans are not the only cause of extinction; and that, independent of human involvement, the extinction of species is also driven by the growth and gradual spread of every animal or plant. Additionally, any changes in the physical geography and climate of the Earth will also likely contribute to this trend. If we go further and ask whether new species periodically replace those that go extinct, and whether there are specific laws set by Nature’s Creator to govern these new creations, we find that the period of human observation is still too brief to provide data that can address such a significant question. All we can do is demonstrate that the ongoing introduction of new species may be a regular part of how the Earth’s system works, without having any right to expect that we should have direct proof of this. The repeated emergence of new species may have easily gone unnoticed, as the number of known animals and plants has increased so rapidly within the lifetimes of people currently living, effectively doubling in some categories and quadrupling in others. It will also be noted later (book iii. chap. 43) that it is generally easier to prove that a species that used to be abundant in a particular area has disappeared if they originally came from a single source, than it is to prove that a new one has come into existence for the first time. Therefore, since there are only one or two clear examples of extinction, namely, the dodo and solitaire (see ch. 41), it is not very reasonable to expect that we should be aware of a single case of a new species appearing for the first time.

Recent origin of man, and gradual approach in the tertiary fossils of successive periods from an extinct to the recent fauna.—The geologist, however, if required to advance some fact which may lend countenance to the opinion that in the most modern times, that is to say, after the greater part of the existing fauna and flora were established on the earth, there has still been a new species superadded, may point to man himself as furnishing the required illustration—for man must be regarded by the geologist as a creature of yesterday, not merely in reference to the past history of the organic world, but also in relation to that particular state of the animate creation of which he forms a part. The comparatively modern introduction of the human race is proved by the absence of the remains of man and his works, not only from all strata containing a certain proportion of fossil shells of extinct species, but even from a large part of the newest strata, in which all the fossil individuals are referable to species still living.

The recent emergence of humans and the gradual transition in tertiary fossils from extinct to modern species.—The geologist, when asked to provide evidence supporting the idea that new species have appeared even after most of today's plants and animals were already established on Earth, can point to humans as a clear example. Humans should be seen by geologists as a recent addition, not just in the context of the history of life on Earth, but also in relation to the current state of living organisms that include us. The relatively recent arrival of the human race is demonstrated by the absence of human remains and artifacts, not only in all layers that contain a certain number of fossil shells from extinct species but also in many of the most recent layers, where all fossil specimens belong to species that still exist.

To enable the reader to appreciate the full force of this evidence, I shall give a slight sketch of the information obtained from the newer strata, respecting fluctuations in the animate world, in times immediately antecedent to the appearance of man.

To help the reader fully grasp the significance of this evidence, I'll provide a brief overview of the information gathered from the newer layers about changes in the living world just before humans appeared.

183 In tracing the series of fossiliferous formations from the more ancient to the more modern, the first deposits in which we meet with assemblages of organic remains, having a near analogy to the fauna of certain parts of the globe in our own time, are those commonly called tertiary. Even in the Eocene, or oldest subdivision of these tertiary formations, some few of the testacea belong to existing species, although almost all of them, and apparently all the associated vertebrata, are now extinct. These Eocene strata are succeeded by a great number of more modern deposits, which depart gradually in the character of their fossils from the Eocene type, and approach more and more to that of the living creation. In the present state of science, it is chiefly by the aid of shells that we are enabled to arrive at these results, for of all classes the testacea are the most generally diffused in a fossil state, and may be called the medals principally employed by nature, in recording the chronology of past events. In the Miocene deposits, which are next in succession to the Eocene, we begin to find a considerable number, although still a minority, of recent species, intermixed with some fossils common to the preceding epoch. We then arrive at the Pliocene strata, in which species now contemporary with man begin to preponderate, and in the newest of which nine-tenths of the fossils agree with species still inhabiting the neighboring sea.

183 When we look at the series of fossil-bearing layers from the oldest to the newest, the first deposits we find that contain groups of organic remains similar to the fauna in certain parts of the world today are those typically called tertiary. Even in the Eocene, the oldest part of these tertiary formations, a few of the shellfish belong to species that still exist, although almost all the others, along with nearly all the associated vertebrates, are now extinct. The Eocene layers are followed by many more recent deposits, which gradually change in the types of fossils they contain, moving closer to those of living organisms. With the current state of science, we mainly rely on shells to reach these conclusions because shellfish are the most widely found in fossil form and can be viewed as nature's primary way of recording the timeline of past events. In the Miocene deposits, which come after the Eocene, we start to see a significant number, though still a minority, of modern species mixed in with some fossils from the previous period. Then, we reach the Pliocene layers, where species coexisting with humans become more common, and in the most recent layers, about ninety percent of the fossils correspond to species that are still found in the nearby sea.

In this passing from the older to the newer members of the tertiary system we meet with many chasms, but none which separate entirely, by a broad line of demarcation, one state of the organic world from another. There are no signs of an abrupt termination of one fauna and flora, and the starting into life of new and wholly distinct forms. Although we are far from being able to demonstrate geologically an insensible transition from the Eocene to the Miocene, or even from the latter to the recent fauna, yet the more we enlarge and perfect our general survey, the more nearly do we approximate to such a continuous series, and the more gradually are we conducted from times when many of the genera and nearly all the species were extinct, to those in which scarcely a single species flourished which we do not know to exist at present. Dr. A. Philippi, indeed, after an elaborate comparison of the fossil tertiary shells of Sicily with those now living in the Mediterranean, announces as the result of his examination that there are strata in that island, which attest a very gradual passage from a period, when only thirteen in a hundred of the shells were like the species now living in the sea, to an era when the recent species had attained a proportion of ninety-five in a hundred. There is therefore evidence, he says, in Sicily of this revolution in the animate world having been effected "without the intervention of any convulsion or abrupt changes, certain species having from time to time died out, and others having been introduced, until at length the existing fauna was elaborated."

In the transition from older to newer members of the tertiary system, we encounter many gaps, but none that completely separate one state of the organic world from another with a clear boundary. There are no signs of a sudden end to one group of plants and animals and the emergence of new, entirely different forms. While we still can't geologically prove a seamless transition from the Eocene to the Miocene, or even from the Miocene to the modern fauna, the more we expand and refine our overall understanding, the closer we get to such a continuous sequence. We move gradually from times when many genera and nearly all species were extinct to those in which hardly a single species existed that we don't recognize today. Dr. A. Philippi, after thoroughly comparing the fossil tertiary shells of Sicily with those still living in the Mediterranean, finds that there are layers in that island showing a very gradual transition. In earlier times, only thirteen out of a hundred of the shells resembled the species currently found in the sea, whereas later, that number increased to ninety-five out of a hundred. He concludes that there is evidence in Sicily of this change in the living world happening "without any major upheaval or abrupt changes, as certain species gradually died out and others were introduced, until eventually the current fauna emerged."

It had often been objected that the evidence of fossil species occurring in two consecutive formations, was confined to the testacea or zoophytes, the characters of which are less marked and decisive than those 184 afforded by the vertebrate animals. But Mr. Owen has lately insisted on the important fact, that not a few of the quadrupeds which now inhabit our island, and among others the horse, the ass, the hog, the smaller wild ox, the goat, the red deer, the roe, the beaver, and many of the diminutive rodents, are the same as those which once coexisted with the mammoth, the great northern hippopotamus, two kinds of rhinoceros, and other mammalia long since extinct. "A part," he observes, "and not the whole of the modern tertiary fauna has perished, and hence we may conclude that the cause of their destruction has not been a violent and universal catastrophe from which none could escape."257

It has often been pointed out that the evidence of fossil species found in two consecutive formations is limited to shellfish or soft-bodied animals, which have less distinct and definitive features than those found in vertebrate animals. However, Mr. Owen has recently emphasized an important fact: several of the mammals currently living on our island, including the horse, donkey, pig, smaller wild ox, goat, red deer, roe deer, beaver, and many small rodents, are the same as those that coexisted with the mammoth, the large northern hippopotamus, two types of rhinoceros, and other mammals that are long extinct. "Some," he notes, "and not all of the modern tertiary fauna has disappeared, so we can conclude that their extinction wasn't caused by a sudden and widespread disaster from which no one could survive."

Had we discovered evidence that man had come into the earth at a period as early as that when a large number of the fossil quadrupeds now living, and almost all the recent species of land, freshwater, and marine shells were in existence, we should have been compelled to ascribe a much higher antiquity to our species, than even the boldest speculations of the ethnologist require, for no small part of the great physical revolution depicted on the map of Europe (Pl. 3), before described, took place very gradually after the recent testacea abounded almost to the exclusion of the extinct. Thus, for example, in the deposits called the "northern drift," or the glacial formation of Europe and North America, the fossil marine shells can easily be identified with species either now inhabiting the neighboring sea, or living in the seas of higher latitudes. Yet they exhibit no memorials of the human race, or of articles fabricated by the hand of man. Some of the newest of these strata passing by the name of "raised beaches," occur at moderate elevations on the coast of England, Scotland, and Ireland. Other examples are met with on a more extended scale in Scandinavia, as at the height of 200 feet at Uddevalla in Sweden, and at twice that elevation, near Christiana, in Norway, also at an altitude of 600 or 700 feet in places farther north. They consist of beds of sand and clay, filling hollows in a district of granite and gneiss, and they must closely resemble the accumulations of shelly matter now in progress at the bottom of the Norwegian fiords. The rate at which the land is now rising in Scandinavia, is far too irregular in different places to afford a safe standard for estimating the minimum of time required for the upheaval 185 of the fundamental granite, and its marine shelly covering, to the height of so many hundred feet; but according to the greatest average, of five or six feet in a century, the period required would be very considerable, and nearly the whole of it, as well as the antecedent epoch of submergence, seems to have preceded the introduction of man into these parts of the earth.

Had we found evidence that humans arrived on Earth as early as when many of the fossil quadrupeds we still see today, along with almost all recent species of land, freshwater, and marine shells, were present, we would have had to assign a much older age to our species than even the boldest theories of anthropologists suggest. A significant part of the major physical changes shown on the map of Europe (Pl. 3), which we described earlier, happened gradually after recent mollusks flourished, almost to the point of excluding extinct species. For instance, in the deposits referred to as the "northern drift," or the glacial formations of Europe and North America, the fossil marine shells can be easily matched with species currently living in the nearby sea or in higher latitude seas. However, there are no traces of the human race or man-made objects found among them. Some of the most recent layers, known as "raised beaches," are found at moderate heights along the coasts of England, Scotland, and Ireland. Other examples can be seen on a larger scale in Scandinavia, such as at an elevation of 200 feet in Uddevalla, Sweden, and at double that height near Oslo, Norway, as well as around 600 or 700 feet in regions further north. These consist of layers of sand and clay that fill depressions in areas of granite and gneiss, resembling the accumulation of shelly material currently forming at the bottoms of the Norwegian fjords. The rate at which the land is rising now in Scandinavia varies too much in different locations to provide a reliable measure for estimating the minimum time needed for the uplift of the foundational granite and its marine shell covering to rise hundreds of feet. However, based on the greatest average of five to six feet per century, the required period would be considerable. Almost all of this time, along with the previous period of submersion, appears to have occurred before humans made their appearance in these parts of the world.

There are other post-tertiary formations of fluviatile origin, in the centre of Europe, in which the absence of human remains is perhaps still more striking, because, when formed, they must have been surrounded by dry land. I allude to the silt or loess of the basin of the Rhine, which must have gradually filled up the great valley of that river since the time when its waters, and the contiguous lands, were inhabited by the existing species of freshwater and terrestrial mollusks. Showers of ashes, thrown out by some of the last eruptions of the Eifel volcanoes, fell during the deposition of this fluviatile silt, and were interstratified with it. But these volcanoes became exhausted, the valley was re-excavated through the silt, and again reduced to its present form before the period of human history. The study, therefore, of this shelly silt reveals to us the history of a long series of events, which occurred after the testacea now living inhabited the land and rivers of Europe, and the whole terminated without any signs of the coming of man into that part of the globe.

There are other post-tertiary formations from rivers located in central Europe, where the lack of human remains is even more noticeable, since they must have been surrounded by dry land when they formed. I'm referring to the silt or loess of the Rhine basin, which has gradually filled up the large valley of that river since the time when its waters and nearby lands were home to the current species of freshwater and land mollusks. Ashes from some of the last eruptions of the Eifel volcanoes fell during the accumulation of this river silt and were layered within it. However, these volcanoes became inactive, the valley was excavated again through the silt, and it was reshaped to its current form before human history began. Therefore, examining this shelly silt reveals a long series of events that took place after the living mollusks occupied the land and rivers of Europe, all of which concluded without any signs of humans arriving in that part of the world.

To cite a still more remarkable example, we observe in Sicily a lofty table-land and hills, sometimes rising to the height of 3000 feet, capped with a limestone, in which from 70 to 85 per cent. of the fossil testacea are specifically identical with those now inhabiting the Mediterranean. These calcareous and other argillaceous strata of the same age are intersected by deep valleys which have been gradually formed by denudation, but have not varied materially in width or depth since Sicily was first colonized by the Greeks. The limestone, moreover, which is of so late a date in geological chronology, was quarried for building those ancient temples of Girgenti and Syracuse, of which the ruins carry us back to a remote era in human history. If we are lost in conjectures when speculating on the ages required to lift up these formations to the height of several thousand feet above the sea, how much more remote must be the era when the same rocks were gradually formed beneath the waters!

To give an even more impressive example, we see in Sicily a high plateau and hills that sometimes rise to about 3000 feet, topped with limestone, in which 70 to 85 percent of the fossil shells are the same species as those currently living in the Mediterranean. These limestone and other clay-like layers of the same age are divided by deep valleys that have slowly formed due to erosion, but have not significantly changed in width or depth since the Greeks first settled Sicily. Additionally, the limestone, which is relatively young in geological terms, was used to build the ancient temples of Girgenti and Syracuse, whose ruins take us back to a distant time in human history. If we feel puzzled when trying to estimate how long it took to raise these formations to thousands of feet above sea level, how much more distant must be the time when the same rocks were slowly formed beneath the sea!

To conclude, it appears that, in going back from the recent to the Eocene period, we are carried by many successive steps from the fauna now contemporary with man to an assemblage of fossil species wholly different from those now living. In this retrospect we have not yet succeeded in tracing back a perfect transition from the recent to an extinct fauna; but there are usually so many species in common to the groups which stand next in succession as to show that there is no great chasm, no signs of a crisis when one class of organic beings was annihilated to give place suddenly to another. This analogy, therefore, derived from a period of the earth's history which can best be compared with the 186 present state of things, and more thoroughly investigated than any other, leads to the conclusion that the extinction and creation of species, has been and is the result of a slow and gradual change in the organic world.

To sum up, it seems that by tracing back from the present to the Eocene period, we can see how many gradual steps lead us from the fauna we know today to a collection of fossil species that are completely different from those alive now. In this look back, we haven't quite managed to find a seamless transition from recent species to extinct ones; however, there are usually many species that are shared between the groups that follow one another, indicating that there's no significant gap and no signs of a major crisis where one group of living organisms was suddenly replaced by another. This analogy, hence, drawn from a part of Earth's history that can be most closely compared to the 186 current situation and has been studied more thoroughly than any other, leads us to conclude that the extinction and emergence of species have been—and still are—the result of a slow and gradual change in the organic world.

UNIFORMITY OF CHANGE CONSIDERED, SECONDLY, IN REFERENCE TO SUBTERRANEAN MOVEMENTS.

To pass on to another of the three topics before proposed for discussion, the reader will find, in the account given in the second book of the earthquakes recorded in history, that certain countries have, from time immemorial, been rudely shaken again and again, while others, comprising by far the largest part of the globe, have remained to all appearance motionless. In the regions of convulsion rocks have been rent asunder, the surface has been forced up into ridges, chasms have opened, or the ground throughout large spaces has been permanently lifted up above or let down below its former level. In the regions of tranquillity some areas have remained at rest, but others have been ascertained by a comparison of measurements, made at different periods, to have risen by an insensible motion, as in Sweden, or to have subsided very slowly, as in Greenland. That these same movements, whether ascending or descending, have continued for ages in the same direction has been established by geological evidence. Thus, we find both on the east and west coast of Sweden, that ground which formerly constituted the bottom of the Baltic and of the ocean has been lifted up to an elevation of several hundred feet above high-water mark. The rise within the historical period has not amounted to many yards, but the greater extent of antecedent upheaval is proved by the occurrence in inland spots, several hundred feet high, of deposits filled with fossil shells of species now living either in the ocean or the Baltic.

To move on to another of the three topics previously suggested for discussion, the reader will find in the account provided in the second book about the recorded earthquakes in history that some countries have been violently shaken repeatedly over the ages, while others, making up the vast majority of the world, seem to have remained completely still. In the areas of seismic activity, rocks have been torn apart, the ground has been pushed up into ridges, fractures have opened up, or large sections of land have been permanently raised or lowered from their previous levels. In the stable regions, some areas have stayed unmoving, but others, as shown by comparing measurements taken at different times, have either quietly risen, like in Sweden, or have slowly subsided, as seen in Greenland. Geological evidence supports that these same movements, whether upward or downward, have continued for ages in the same direction. For example, along both the east and west coasts of Sweden, land that used to be at the bottom of the Baltic Sea and the ocean has risen to several hundred feet above sea level. The rise observed in historical times has not been very much, but the significant amount of earlier uplift is evidenced by finding deposits filled with fossil shells of species that now live either in the ocean or the Baltic at heights several hundred feet above sea level.

To detect proofs of slow and gradual subsidence must in general be more difficult; but the theory which accounts for the form of circular coral reefs and lagoon islands, and which will be explained in the last chapter of the third book, will satisfy the reader that there are spaces on the globe, several thousand miles in circumference, throughout which the downward movement has predominated for ages, and yet the land has never, in a single instance, gone down suddenly for several hundred feet at once. Yet geology demonstrates that the persistency of subterranean movements in one direction has not been perpetual throughout all past time. There have been great oscillations of level by which a surface of dry land has been submerged to a depth of several thousand feet, and then at a period long subsequent raised again and made to emerge. Nor have the regions now motionless been always at rest; and some of those which are at present the theatres of reiterated earthquakes have formerly enjoyed a long continuance of tranquillity. But although disturbances have ceased after having long prevailed, or have recommenced after a suspension for ages, there has been no universal disruption of the earth's crust or desolation of the surface since times 187 the most remote. The non-occurrence of such a general convulsion is proved by the perfect horizontally now retained by some of the most ancient fossiliferous strata throughout wide areas.

Detecting evidence of slow and gradual sinking is generally more challenging; however, the theory that explains the shape of circular coral reefs and lagoon islands— which will be detailed in the final chapter of the third book— will convince the reader that there are areas on Earth, several thousand miles across, where downward movement has dominated for ages, and yet the land has never, in any instance, suddenly dropped hundreds of feet at once. Still, geology shows that the consistent underground movements in one direction haven't lasted throughout all of history. There have been significant changes in elevation where dry land has been submerged to depths of several thousand feet, only to be raised again and brought back to the surface much later. Moreover, areas that are currently stable haven't always been so; some regions that are now frequently shaken by earthquakes once experienced long periods of calm. But even though disturbances have stopped after a long time or have started again after a lengthy break, there hasn't been a worldwide upheaval of the Earth's crust or devastation of the surface since very ancient times. The absence of such a major disturbance is evident from the perfectly horizontal layers found in some of the oldest fossil-rich strata across extensive areas.

Inferences derived from unconformable strata.—That the subterranean forces have visited different parts of the globe at successive periods, is inferred chiefly from the unconformability of strata belonging to groups of different ages. Thus, for example, on the borders of Wales and Shropshire we find the slaty beds of the ancient Silurian system curved and vertical, while the beds of the overlying carboniferous shale and sandstone are horizontal. All are agreed, that in such a case the older set of strata had suffered great dislocation before the deposition of the newer or carboniferous beds, and that these last have never since been convulsed by any movements of excessive violence. But the strata of the inferior group suffered only a local derangement, and rocks of the same age are by no means found everywhere in a curved or vertical position. In various parts of Europe, and particularly near Lake Wener in the south of Sweden, and in many parts of Russia, beds of the same Silurian system maintain the most perfect horizontality; and a similar observation may be made respecting limestones and shales of the like antiquity in the great lake district of Canada and the United States. They are still as flat and horizontal as when first formed; yet since their origin not only have most of the actual mountain-chains been uplifted, but the very rocks of which those mountains are composed have been formed.

Inferences drawn from unconformable layers.—The idea that underground forces have affected different parts of the world at different times mainly comes from the unconformability of layers from various ages. For instance, along the borders of Wales and Shropshire, we see the slaty beds of the ancient Silurian system are curved and vertical, while the layers of the newer carboniferous shale and sandstone are horizontal. Everyone agrees that in this case, the older strata experienced significant displacement before the deposition of the newer carboniferous layers, and these newer layers haven't been disturbed by major movements since then. However, the lower group of layers only faced local disturbances, and rocks of the same age are not consistently found in a curved or vertical position everywhere. In various locations in Europe, especially near Lake Vänern in southern Sweden and in many areas of Russia, strata of the same Silurian system remain completely horizontal; a similar observation applies to limestones and shales of similar age in the great lake region of Canada and the United States. They are still as flat and level as when they were first formed; yet since their origin, not only have most of the existing mountain ranges been lifted, but the very rocks that make up those mountains have also formed.

It would be easy to multiply instances of similar unconformability in formations of other ages; but a few more will suffice. The coal measures before alluded to as horizontal on the borders of Wales are vertical in the Mendip Hills in Somersetshire, where the overlying beds of the New Red Sandstone are horizontal. Again, in the Wolds of Yorkshire the last mentioned sandstone supports on its curved and inclined beds the horizontal Chalk. The Chalk again is vertical on the flanks of the Pyrenees, and the tertiary strata repose unconformably upon it.

It would be easy to find more examples of similar inconsistencies in formations from different ages, but a few more will do. The coal layers previously mentioned as horizontal at the edges of Wales are vertical in the Mendip Hills in Somerset, where the overlying layers of New Red Sandstone are horizontal. Similarly, in the Yorkshire Wolds, the last referred sandstone supports the horizontal Chalk on its curved and tilted beds. The Chalk, in turn, is vertical on the slopes of the Pyrenees, with the tertiary layers resting unconformably on it.

Consistency of local disturbances with general uniformity.—As almost every country supplies illustrations of the same phenomena, they who advocate the doctrine of alternate periods of disorder and repose may appeal to the facts above described, as proving that every district has been by turns convulsed by earthquakes and then respited for ages from convulsions. But so it might with equal truth be affirmed that every part of Europe has been visited alternately by winter and summer, although it has always been winter and always summer in some part of the planet, and neither of these seasons has ever reigned simultaneously over the entire globe. They have been always shifting about from place to place; but the vicissitudes which recur thus annually in a single spot are never allowed to interfere with the invariable uniformity of seasons throughout the whole planet.

Consistency of local disturbances with general uniformity.—Since almost every country showcases similar phenomena, those who support the idea of alternating periods of chaos and calm can point to the facts mentioned above as evidence that every region has experienced cycles of earthquakes followed by long periods of peace. However, it could be just as accurately stated that every part of Europe has alternated between winter and summer, even though there has always been winter and always summer somewhere on the planet, and neither of these seasons has ever existed at the same time across the entire globe. They consistently shift from one location to another; yet, the changes that occur annually in one area do not disrupt the overall uniformity of seasons around the planet.

So, in regard to subterranean movements, the theory of the perpetual uniformity of the force which they exert on the earth's crust is 188 quite consistent with the admission of their alternate development and suspension for indefinite periods within limited geographical areas.

So, when it comes to underground movements, the idea that the force they exert on the earth's crust remains constant is 188 completely compatible with the acknowledgment that these forces can develop and pause for indefinite periods in specific geographical areas.

UNIFORMITY OF CHANGE CONSIDERED, THIRDLY, IN REFERENCE TO SEDIMENTARY DEPOSITION.

It now remains to speak of the laws governing the deposition of new strata. If we survey the surface of the globe we immediately perceive that it is divisible into areas of deposition and non-deposition, or, in other words, at any given time there are spaces which are the recipients, others which are not the recipients of sedimentary matter. No new strata, for example, are thrown down on dry land, which remains the same from year to year; whereas, in many parts of the bottom of seas and lakes, mud, sand, and pebbles are annually spread out by rivers and currents. There are also great masses of limestone growing in some seas, or in mid-ocean, chiefly composed of corals and shells.

It is now time to discuss the laws that govern the formation of new layers. If we look at the Earth's surface, we quickly notice that it can be divided into areas where deposition occurs and areas where it does not. In other words, at any given time, there are places that receive sedimentary material and others that do not. For instance, no new layers are created on dry land, which stays the same year after year. Meanwhile, in many parts of the ocean and lakes, mud, sand, and pebbles are continually deposited by rivers and currents. Additionally, large amounts of limestone are forming in certain seas or in the open ocean, primarily made up of coral and shells.

No sediment deposited on dry land.—As to the dry land, so far from being the receptacle of fresh accessions of matter, it is exposed almost everywhere to waste away. Forests may be as dense and lofty as those of Brazil, and may swarm with quadrupeds, birds, and insects, yet at the end of ten thousand years one layer of black mould, a few inches thick, may be the sole representative of those myriads of trees, leaves, flowers, and fruits, those innumerable bones and skeletons of birds, quadrupeds, and reptiles, which tenanted the fertile region. Should this land be at length submerged, the waves of the sea may wash away in a few hours the scanty covering of mould, and it may merely impart a darker shade of color to the next stratum of marl, sand, or other matter newly thrown down. So also at the bottom of the ocean where no sediment is accumulating, sea-weed, zoophytes, fish, and even shells, may multiply for ages and decompose, leaving no vestige of their form or substance behind. Their decay, in water, although more slow, is as certain and eventually as complete as in the open air. Nor can they be perpetuated for indefinite periods in a fossil state, unless imbedded in some matrix which is impervious to water, or which at least does not allow a free percolation of that fluid, impregnated as it usually is, with a slight quantity of carbonic or other acid. Such a free percolation may be prevented either by the mineral nature of the matrix itself, or by the superposition of an impermeable stratum: but if unimpeded, the fossil shell or bone will be dissolved and removed, particle after particle, and thus entirely effaced, unless petrifaction or the substitution of mineral for organic matter happen to take place.

No sediment deposited on dry land.—Regarding dry land, instead of being a place where new material accumulates, it is almost everywhere subject to erosion. Forests can be as thick and tall as those in Brazil, teeming with animals, birds, and insects, yet after ten thousand years, all that might remain is one layer of black soil just a few inches deep, representing the countless trees, leaves, flowers, and fruits, along with the myriad bones and skeletons of birds, mammals, and reptiles that once inhabited the fertile area. If this land eventually gets submerged, the ocean's waves could wash away this thin layer of soil in just a few hours, leaving only a darker tint on the next layer of marl, sand, or newly deposited materials. Similarly, at the ocean's bottom, where no sediment builds up, seaweed, zoophytes, fish, and even shells can thrive and decompose for ages, leaving no trace of their form or substance behind. Their decay in water, although slower, is just as certain and ultimately as complete as it is in the open air. They cannot be preserved indefinitely as fossils unless encased in some material that prevents water from penetrating it or at least limits its flow, which often contains a small amount of carbonic or other acid. This unrestricted flow can be halted by the mineral composition of the material itself or by an overlay of an impermeable layer; but if unhindered, the fossil shell or bone will gradually dissolve and be removed, particle by particle, until it is entirely gone, unless petrification or the replacement of organic material with minerals occurs.

That there has been land as well as sea at all former geological periods, we know from the fact, that fossil trees and terrestrial plants are imbedded in rocks of every age. Occasionally lacustrine and fluviatile shells, insects, or the bones of amphibious or land reptiles, point to the 189 same conclusion. The existence of dry land at all periods of the past implies, as before mentioned, the partial deposition of sediment, or its limitation to certain areas; and the next point to which I shall call the reader's attention, is the shifting of these areas from one region to another.

We know that there has been land as well as sea throughout all previous geological periods because fossilized trees and land plants can be found in rocks of every age. Occasionally, lake and river shells, insects, or the bones of amphibians or land reptiles support the same conclusion. The presence of dry land at all times in the past suggests, as mentioned earlier, that sediment was partially deposited or restricted to certain areas; and the next point I want to highlight is the movement of these areas from one region to another.

First, then, variations in the site of sedimentary deposition are brought about independently of subterranean movements. There is always a slight change from year to year, or from century to century. The sediment of the Rhone, for example, thrown into the Lake of Geneva, is now conveyed to a spot a mile and a half distant from that where it accumulated in the tenth century, and six miles from the point where the delta began originally to form. We may look forward to the period when this lake will be filled up, and then the distribution of the transported matter will be suddenly altered, for the mud and sand brought down from the Alps will thenceforth, instead of being deposited near Geneva, be carried nearly 200 miles southwards, where the Rhone enters the Mediterranean.

First, variations in where sediment is deposited happen independently of underground movements. There’s always a small change from year to year or from century to century. The sediment from the Rhone, for instance, which is dumped into Lake Geneva, is now being moved to a location a mile and a half away from where it gathered in the tenth century, and six miles from where the delta first started to form. We can anticipate the time when this lake will be completely filled, and then the way the sediment is distributed will be suddenly changed, because the mud and sand coming from the Alps will, from that point on, be carried nearly 200 miles south to where the Rhone flows into the Mediterranean.

In the deltas of large rivers, such as those of the Ganges and Indus, the mud is first carried down for many centuries through one arm, and on this being stopped up it is discharged by another, and may then enter the sea at a point 50 or 100 miles distant from its first receptacle. The direction of marine currents is also liable to be changed by various accidents, as by the heaping up of new sand-banks, or the wearing away of cliffs and promontories.

In the deltas of major rivers like the Ganges and Indus, the mud is transported for centuries through one channel. When that channel gets blocked, the mud is released through another, often reaching the sea 50 to 100 miles away from where it first collected. The flow of ocean currents can also shift due to various factors, like the formation of new sandbanks or the erosion of cliffs and headlands.

But, secondly, all these causes of fluctuation in the sedimentary areas are entirely subordinate to those great upward or downward movements of land which have been already described as prevailing over large tracts of the globe. By such elevation or subsidence certain spaces are gradually submerged, or made gradually to emerge:—in the one case sedimentary deposition may be suddenly renewed after having been suspended for ages, in the other as suddenly made to cease after having continued for an indefinite period.

But, on the other hand, all these reasons for changes in the sedimentary areas are completely secondary to the major upward or downward movements of land that have already been described as affecting large parts of the world. Through these rises or falls, certain areas are either gradually submerged or gradually brought to the surface: in one case, sedimentary deposition can suddenly restart after being on hold for ages, while in the other case, it can just as suddenly stop after continuing for an unknown period.

Causes of variation in mineral character of successive sedimentary groups.—If deposition be renewed after a long interval, the new strata will usually differ greatly from the sedimentary rocks previously formed in the same place, and especially if the older rocks have suffered derangement, which implies a change in the physical geography of the district since the previous conveyance of sediment to the same spot. It may happen, however, that, even when the inferior group is horizontal and conformable to the upper strata, these last may still differ entirely in mineral character, because since the origin of the older formation the geography of some distant country has been altered. In that country rocks before concealed may have become exposed by denudation; volcanoes may have burst out and covered the surface with scoriæ and lava, or new lakes may have been formed by subsidence; and other fluctuations may have occurred, by which the materials brought down from thence by rivers to the sea have acquired a distinct mineral character.

Causes of variation in mineral character of successive sedimentary groups.—If deposition resumes after a long break, the new layers typically differ significantly from the sedimentary rocks that were formed in the same location before, especially if the older rocks have been disturbed. This disturbance suggests changes in the physical geography of the area since the last time sediment was deposited there. However, even when the lower group is horizontal and aligns with the upper layers, the upper layers can still be completely different in mineral content. This can happen because, since the older formation was created, the geography of a distant area may have changed. In that area, rocks that were once buried might have become exposed due to erosion; volcanoes may have erupted, covering the ground with ash and lava, or new lakes may have formed due to sinking land. Other changes could have taken place, leading to the materials carried by rivers to the sea developing a unique mineral character.

190 It is well known that the stream of the Mississippi is charged with sediment of a different color from that of the Arkansas and Red Rivers, which are tinged with red mud, derived from rocks of porphyry in "the far west." The waters of the Uruguay, says Darwin, draining a granitic country, are clear and black, those of the Parana, red.258 The mud with which the Indus is loaded, says Burnes, is of a clayey hue, that of the Chenab, on the other hand, is reddish, that of the Sutlej is more pale.259 The same causes which make these several rivers, sometimes situated at no great distance the one from the other, to differ greatly in the character of their sediment, will make the waters draining the same country at different epochs, especially before and after great revolutions in physical geography, to be entirely dissimilar. It is scarcely necessary to add, that marine currents will be affected in an analogous manner in consequence of the formation of new shoals, the emergence of new islands, the subsidence of others, the gradual waste of neighboring coasts, the growth of new deltas, the increase of coral reefs, and other changes.

190 It's well-known that the Mississippi River carries sediment that's different in color from the Arkansas and Red Rivers, which are colored by red mud from porphyry rocks found in "the far west." The waters of the Uruguay, according to Darwin, are clear and black because they flow through granitic terrain, while the Parana is red.258 Burnes notes that the mud in the Indus has a clay-like color, the Chenab's is reddish, and the Sutlej's is paler.259 The same factors that cause significant differences in the sediment of these rivers, which are sometimes close to each other, will also lead to the waters draining the same area at different times—especially before and after major physical changes in geography—being completely different. It's hardly necessary to point out that ocean currents will similarly be influenced by the creation of new shoals, the rise of new islands, the sinking of others, the gradual erosion of nearby coasts, the formation of new deltas, the expansion of coral reefs, and other changes.

Why successive sedimentary groups contain distinct fossils.—If, in the next place, we assume, for reasons before stated, a continual extinction of species and introduction of others into the globe, it will then follow that the fossils of strata formed at two distant periods on the same spot, will differ even more certainly than the mineral composition of the same. For rocks of the same kind have sometimes been reproduced in the same district after a long interval of time, whereas there are no facts leading to the opinion that species which have once died out have ever been reproduced. The submergence then of land must be often attended by the commencement of a new class of sedimentary deposits, characterized by a new set of fossil animals and plants, while the reconversion of the bed of the sea into land may arrest at once and for an indefinite time the formation of geological monuments. Should the land again sink, strata will again be formed; but one or many entire revolutions in animal or vegetable life may have been completed in the interval.

Why successive sedimentary groups contain distinct fossils.—If we assume, for the reasons mentioned earlier, that species continually go extinct and new ones are introduced to the planet, then the fossils found in layers formed at two different times in the same location will differ even more clearly than the mineral makeup of those layers. This is because rocks of the same type can sometimes form again in the same area after a long time, while there is no evidence that species which have gone extinct ever come back. Therefore, when land is submerged, it often marks the beginning of a new type of sedimentary deposits, which are characterized by a different set of fossil animals and plants. Conversely, when the sea floor becomes land again, it can halt the formation of geological structures for an indefinite period. If the land sinks again, new layers will form; however, one or several entire changes in animal or plant life could have occurred in the meantime.

Conditions requisite for the original completeness of a fossiliferous series.—If we infer, for reasons before explained, that fluctuations in the animate world are brought about by the slow and successive removal and creation of species, we shall be convinced that a rare combination of circumstances alone can give rise to such a series of strata as will bear testimony to a gradual passage from one state of organic life to another. To produce such strata nothing less will be requisite than the fortunate coincidence of the following conditions: first, a never-failing supply of sediment in the same region throughout a period of vast duration; secondly, the fitness of the deposit in every part for the permanent preservation of imbedded fossils; and, thirdly, a gradual 191 subsidence to prevent the sea or lake from being filled up and converted into land.

Conditions necessary for the original completeness of a fossil-rich series.—If we assume, for the reasons discussed earlier, that changes in the living world result from the slow and gradual removal and creation of species, we will be convinced that only a rare combination of circumstances can lead to a series of layers that provide evidence of a gradual transition from one form of organic life to another. To create such layers, the fortunate coincidence of the following conditions is essential: first, a consistent supply of sediment in the same area over a long period; secondly, the suitability of the deposit in every location for the permanent preservation of embedded fossils; and thirdly, a gradual 191 subsidence to prevent the sea or lake from filling up and turning into land.

It will appear in the chapter on coral reefs,260 that, in certain parts of the Pacific and Indian Oceans, most of these conditions, if not all, are complied with, and the constant growth of coral, keeping pace with the sinking of the bottom of the sea, seems to have gone on so slowly, for such indefinite periods, that the signs of a gradual change in organic life might probably be detected in that quarter of the globe, if we could explore its submarine geology. Instead of the growth of coralline limestone, let us suppose, in some other place, the continuous deposition of fluviatile mud and sand, such as the Ganges and Brahmapootra have poured for thousands of years into the Bay of Bengal. Part of this bay, although of considerable depth, might at length be filled up before an appreciable amount of change was effected in the fish, mollusca, and other inhabitants of the sea and neighboring land. But, if the bottom be lowered by sinking at the same rate that it is raised by fluviatile mud, the bay can never be turned into dry land. In that case one new layer of matter may be superimposed upon another for a thickness of many thousand feet, and the fossils of the inferior beds may differ greatly from those entombed in the uppermost, yet every intermediate gradation may be indicated in the passage from an older to a newer assemblage of species. Granting, however, that such an unbroken sequence of monuments may thus be elaborated in certain parts of the sea, and that the strata happen to be all of them well adapted to preserve the included fossils from decomposition, how many accidents must still concur before these submarine formations will be laid open to our investigation! The whole deposit must first be raised several thousand feet, in order to bring into view the very foundation; and during the process of exposure the superior beds must not be entirely swept away by denudation.

It will be discussed in the chapter on coral reefs,260 that in some areas of the Pacific and Indian Oceans, most, if not all, of these conditions are met, and the slow, ongoing growth of coral, matching the sinking of the ocean floor, seems to have occurred over such long periods that we could likely detect gradual changes in marine life if we could examine the underwater geology. Instead of just the growth of coral limestone, let’s consider a scenario where there is continuous deposition of freshwater mud and sand, similar to what the Ganges and Brahmaputra rivers have been delivering into the Bay of Bengal for thousands of years. Parts of this bay, even though they are quite deep, might eventually be filled before we see any significant changes in the fish, mollusks, and other creatures living in the sea and on nearby land. However, if the ocean floor sinks at the same rate that it is raised by sediment, the bay will never become dry land. In that case, one new layer can build on top of another, reaching thicknesses of several thousand feet, and the fossils in the lower layers might differ significantly from those in the topmost layers, yet every transition may be reflected in the shift from older to newer species. Even if such an uninterrupted sequence of geological layers can be established in some parts of the ocean, and all the strata happen to be well-suited to preserve the fossils from decay, there are still many factors that must align before these underwater formations can be examined! The entire deposit must first be raised several thousand feet to reveal the very bottom layers; and during this exposure process, the upper layers must not be completely eroded away.

In the first place, the chances are as three to one against the mere emergence of the mass above the waters, because three-fourths of the globe are covered by the ocean. But if it be upheaved and made to constitute part of the dry land, it must also, before it can be available for our instruction, become part of that area already surveyed by geologists; and this area comprehends perhaps less than a tenth of the whole earth. In this small fraction of land already explored, and still very imperfectly known, we are required to find a set of strata, originally of limited extent, and probably much lessened by subsequent denudation.

First of all, the odds are three to one against the mass simply rising above the waters, since three-quarters of the planet is covered by the ocean. But if it does rise and becomes part of the land, it still needs to be in an area that geologists have already mapped in order for us to learn from it; this area is likely less than a tenth of the entire Earth. In this small portion of land that has been explored, which is still not well understood, we need to find a set of layers that were originally limited in size and probably significantly reduced by later erosion.

Yet it is precisely because we do not encounter at every step the evidence of such gradations from one state of the organic world to another, that so many geologists embrace the doctrine of great and sudden revolutions in the history of the animate world. Not content with simply availing themselves, for the convenience of classification, of 192 those gaps and chasms which here and there interrupt the continuity of the chronological series, as at present known, they deduce, from the frequency of these breaks in the chain of records, an irregular mode of succession in the events themselves both in the organic and inorganic world. But, besides that some links of the chain which once existed are now clearly lost and others concealed from view, we have good reason to suspect that it was never complete originally. It may undoubtedly be said, that strata have been always forming somewhere, and therefore at every moment of past time nature has added a page to her archives; but, in reference to this subject, it should be remembered that we can never hope to compile a consecutive history by gathering together monuments which were originally detached and scattered over the globe. For as the species of organic beings contemporaneously inhabiting remote regions are distinct, the fossils of the first of several periods which may be preserved in any one country, as in America, for example, will have no connection with those of a second period found in India, and will therefore no more enable us to trace the signs of a gradual change in the living creation, than a fragment of Chinese history will fill up a blank in the political annals of Europe.

Yet it's exactly because we don't see evidence of such gradual changes from one state of the organic world to another at every turn that many geologists support the idea of major and sudden shifts in the history of life. Instead of just using, for ease of classification, those gaps and breaks that occasionally interrupt the chronological series we know now, they conclude, based on how often these breaks occur in the record, that there's an irregular pattern in the events themselves in both the organic and inorganic worlds. However, aside from some links in the chain that clearly no longer exist and others that remain hidden, we have strong reasons to suspect that it was never fully complete to begin with. It can certainly be said that layers of earth have always been forming somewhere, so at every moment in the past, nature has added a page to her archives. But in relation to this topic, we should keep in mind that we can never hope to create a continuous history by piecing together artifacts that were originally separate and scattered across the globe. Just as the species of living organisms found in distant regions are distinct, the fossils from one of several periods that might be preserved in a single country, like America, won't connect with those from another period found in India. Thus, they won't help us trace the signs of gradual change in living creatures any more than a piece of Chinese history would fill a gap in the political history of Europe.

The absence of any deposits of importance containing recent shells in Chili, or anywhere on the western coast of South America, naturally led Mr. Darwin to the conclusion that "where the bed of the sea is either stationary or rising, circumstances are far less favorable than where the level is sinking to the accumulation of conchiferous strata of sufficient thickness and extension to resist the average vast amount of denudation."261 An examination of the superficial clay, sand, and gravel of the most modern date in Norway and Sweden, where the land is also rising, would incline us to admit a similar proposition. Yet in these cases there has been a supply of sediment from the waste of the coast and the interior, especially in Patagonia and Chili. Nevertheless wherever the bottom of the sea has been continually elevated, the total thickness of sedimentary matter accumulating at depths suited to the habitation of most of the species of shells can never be great, nor can the deposits be thickly covered by superincumbent matter, so as to be consolidated by pressure. When they are upheaved, therefore, the waves on the beach will bear down and disperse the loose materials; whereas if the bed of the sea subsides slowly, a mass of strata containing abundance of such species as live at moderate depths may increase in thickness to any amount, and may extend over a broad area, as the water gradually encroaches on the land. If, then, at particular periods, as in the Miocene epoch, for example, both in Europe and North America, contemporaneous shelly deposits have originated, and have been preserved at very distant points, it may arise from the prevalence at that period of simultaneous subsidence throughout very wide areas. The absence in the same quarters of the globe of strata marking the 193 ages which immediately succeeded, may be accounted for by supposing that the level of the bed of the sea and the adjoining land was stationary or was undergoing slow upheaval.

The lack of significant deposits containing recent shells in Chile or anywhere along the western coast of South America led Mr. Darwin to conclude that "where the seabed is either stable or rising, the conditions are much less favorable than where the level is sinking for the accumulation of shell-bearing layers thick enough and extensive enough to withstand the typical large amount of erosion." 261 Examining the surface clay, sand, and gravel of the most recent origin in Norway and Sweden, where the land is also rising, would suggest a similar idea. However, in these instances, there has been a supply of sediment from coastal erosion and inland sources, especially in Patagonia and Chile. Nonetheless, in places where the seabed has been consistently elevated, the overall thickness of sediment accumulating at depths suitable for most shell species can never be substantial, nor can the deposits be deeply buried under additional material to be compacted by pressure. When they are uplifted, the waves on the shore will wash away and scatter the loose materials; whereas, if the seabed subsides slowly, a layer of deposits rich in species that thrive at moderate depths can thicken significantly and spread over a large area as the water gradually encroaches on the land. If, then, during certain periods, like the Miocene epoch for instance, contemporary shell deposits appeared and were preserved at very distant locations, it may be due to widespread subsidence occurring at that time across extensive areas. The absence of layers in the same regions of the world marking the ages immediately following can be explained by the assumption that the level of the seabed and the nearby land was stable or was undergoing slow uplift.

How far some of the great violations of continuity which now exist in the chronological table of fossiliferous rocks, will hereafter be removed or lessened, must at present be mere matter of conjecture. The hiatus which exists in Great Britain between the fossils of the Lias and those of the Magnesian Limestone, is supplied in Germany by the rich fauna and flora of the Muschelkalk, Keuper, and Bunter Sandstein, which we know to be of a date precisely intermediate; those three formations being interposed in Germany between others which agree perfectly in their organic remains with our Lias and Magnesian Limestone. Until lately the fossils of the Coal-measures were separated from those of the antecedent Silurian group by a very abrupt and decided line of demarcation; but recent discoveries have brought to light in Devonshire, Belgium, the Eifel, and Westphalia, the remains of a fauna of an intervening period. This connecting link is furnished by the fossil shells, fish, and corals of the Devonian or Old Red Sandstone group, and some species of this newly intercalated fauna are found to be common to it and the subjacent Silurian rocks, while other species belong to it in common with the Coal-measures. We have also in like manner had some success of late years in diminishing the hiatus which still separates the Cretaceous and Eocene periods in Europe. Still we must expect, for reasons before stated, that some such chasms will forever continue to occur in some parts of our sedimentary series.

How much of the significant gaps in the timeline of fossil-rich rocks will be cleared up or reduced in the future is currently just a guess. The gap in Great Britain between the fossils from the Lias and those from the Magnesian Limestone is filled in Germany by the diverse plant and animal life of the Muschelkalk, Keuper, and Bunter Sandstone, which we know are from a time that fits perfectly in between; these three formations sit between other formations in Germany that match our Lias and Magnesian Limestone fossils exactly. Until recently, the fossils from the Coal Measures were sharply separated from those of the older Silurian group by a clear line. However, recent findings in Devonshire, Belgium, the Eifel, and Westphalia have uncovered fossils from a transitional period. This link is provided by the fossil shells, fish, and corals of the Devonian or Old Red Sandstone group, and some species from this newly identified fauna are shared with both the Silurian rocks below it and the Coal Measures. Similarly, we have also made progress in closing the gap between the Cretaceous and Eocene periods in Europe in recent years. However, we must accept that, for the reasons mentioned earlier, some gaps will likely always exist in certain parts of our sedimentary record.

Consistency of the theory of gradual change with the existence of great breaks in the series.—To return to the general argument pursued in this chapter, it is assumed, for reasons above explained, that a slow change of species is in simultaneous operation everywhere throughout the habitable surface of sea and land; whereas the fossilization of plants and animals is confined to those areas where new strata are produced. These areas, as we have seen, are always shifting their position; so that the fossilizing process, by means of which the commemoration of the particular state of the organic world, at any given time, is affected, may be said to move about, visiting and revisiting different tracts in succession.

Consistency of the theory of gradual change with the existence of great breaks in the series.—To return to the overall argument made in this chapter, it is assumed, for the reasons explained above, that a slow change in species is occurring simultaneously everywhere across the habitable areas of sea and land; while the fossilization of plants and animals is limited to those locations where new layers are formed. These locations, as we have observed, are always shifting; thus, the fossilizing process, through which the specific state of the organic world at any given moment is recorded, can be said to move about, visiting and revisiting different areas in succession.

To make still more clear the supposed working of this machinery, I shall compare it to a somewhat analogous case that might be imagined to occur in the history of human affairs. Let the mortality of the population of a large country represent the successive extinction of species, and the births of new individuals the introduction of new species. While these fluctuations are gradually taking place everywhere, suppose commissioners to be appointed to visit each province of the country in succession, taking an exact account of the number, names, and individual peculiarities of all the inhabitants, and leaving in each district a register containing a record of this information. If, after the completion of one census, another is immediately made on the same plan, and then another, there will, at last, be a series of statistical documents in each 194 province. When those belonging to any one province are arranged in chronological order, the contents of such as stand next to each other will differ according to the length of the intervals of time between the taking of each census. If, for example, there are sixty provinces, and all the registers are made in a single year, and renewed annually, the number of births and deaths will be so small, in proportion to the whole of the inhabitants, during the interval between the compiling of the two consecutive documents, that the individuals described in such documents will be nearly identical; whereas, if the survey of each of the sixty provinces occupies all the commissioners for a whole year, so that they are unable to revisit the same place until the expiration of sixty years, there will then be an almost entire discordance between the persons enumerated in two consecutive registers in the same province. There are, undoubtedly, other causes besides the mere quantity of time, which may augment or diminish the amount of discrepancy. Thus, at some periods a pestilential disease may have lessened the average duration of human life, or a variety of circumstances may have caused the births to be unusually numerous, and the population to multiply; or, a province may be suddenly colonized by persons migrating from surrounding districts.

To clarify how this machinery is supposed to work, I’ll compare it to a somewhat similar situation that could happen in human history. Imagine that the death rate in a large country represents the gradual extinction of species, while the births of new individuals symbolize the introduction of new species. As these changes happen over time, picture officials being assigned to visit each province of the country in turn, gathering detailed information on the number, names, and unique characteristics of all the inhabitants, and leaving behind a record in each district. If, after completing one census, another is conducted in the same manner, and then another, there will eventually be a series of statistical documents in each 194 province. When the documents from any one province are arranged chronologically, the contents of those that are next to each other will differ based on the time intervals between each census. For example, if there are sixty provinces and all the records are collected in a single year, updated annually, the number of births and deaths during the time between two consecutive documents will be so minimal, relative to the total population, that the individuals described in those documents will nearly be the same. However, if covering each of the sixty provinces takes the officials a whole year, meaning they can’t revisit the same place for sixty years, there will be a significant discrepancy between the people listed in two consecutive records for the same province. There are certainly other factors besides just the time span that could increase or decrease the amount of difference. For instance, at certain times, a destructive disease might reduce the average lifespan, or various circumstances could lead to an unusually high number of births and a growing population; additionally, a province might suddenly be populated by people migrating from nearby areas.

These exceptions may be compared to the accelerated rate of fluctuation in the fauna and flora of a particular region, in which the climate and physical geography may be undergoing an extraordinary degree of alteration.

These exceptions can be likened to the fast-changing patterns of wildlife and plant life in a specific area, where the climate and physical geography might be experiencing significant changes.

But I must remind the reader, that the case above proposed has no pretensions to be regarded as an exact parallel to the geological phenomena which I desire to illustrate; for the commissioners are supposed to visit the different provinces in rotation; whereas the commemorating processes by which organic remains become fossilized, although they are always shifting from one area to the other, are yet very irregular in their movements. They may abandon and revisit many spaces again and again before they once approach another district; and, besides this source of irregularity, it may often happen that, while the depositing process is suspended, denudation may take place, which may be compared to the occasional destruction by fire or other causes of some of the statistical documents before mentioned. It is evident that, where such accidents occur, the want of continuity in the series may become indefinitely great, and that the monuments which follow next in succession will by no means be equidistant from each other in point of time.

But I need to remind the reader that the example given doesn't claim to be a perfect match for the geological phenomena I want to illustrate. The commissioners are expected to visit different provinces in order, while the processes that cause organic remains to become fossilized, although always moving from one place to another, are very irregular in their movements. They might leave and come back to the same areas multiple times before moving to a new region. Additionally, while the deposition process is on hold, erosion can happen, which can be likened to the occasional loss of some of the previously mentioned statistical documents due to fire or other reasons. It’s clear that when such events take place, the gaps in the sequence can become quite significant, and the artifacts that follow will not be equally spaced in time.

If this train of reasoning be admitted, the occasional distinctness of the fossil remains, in formations immediately in contact, would be a necessary consequence of the existing laws of sedimentary deposition and subterranean movement, accompanied by a constant mortality and renovation of species.

If we accept this line of thinking, the occasional clarity of the fossil remains in layers that are directly in contact would be a natural result of the current laws of sedimentary deposition and underground movement, along with a continuous cycle of species dying out and being replaced.

As all the conclusions above insisted on are directly opposed to opinions still popular, I shall add another comparison, in the hope of preventing any possible misapprehension of the argument. Suppose we 195 had discovered two buried cities at the foot of Vesuvius, immediately superimposed upon each other, with a great mass of tuff and lava intervening, just as Portici and Resina, if now covered with ashes, would overlie Herculaneum. An antiquary might possibly be entitled to infer, from the inscriptions on public edifices, that the inhabitants of the inferior and older city were Greeks, and those of the modern towns Italians. But he would reason very hastily if he also concluded from these data that there had been a sudden change from the Greek to the Italian language in Campania. But if he afterwards found three buried cities, one above the other, the intermediate one being Roman, while, as in the former example, the lowest was Greek and the uppermost Italian, he would then perceive the fallacy of his former opinion, and would begin to suspect that the catastrophes by which the cities were inhumed might have no relation whatever to the fluctuations in the language of the inhabitants; and that, as the Roman tongue had evidently intervened between the Greek and Italian, so many other dialects may have been spoken in succession, and the passage from the Greek to the Italian may have been very gradual; some terms growing obsolete, while others were introduced from time to time.

Since all the conclusions mentioned above go against some still common opinions, I'll add another comparison to clarify the argument. Imagine we195 discovered two buried cities at the foot of Vesuvius, stacked on top of each other, with a significant amount of tuff and lava in between, just like Portici and Resina would lie over Herculaneum if they were buried in ashes. An expert might be tempted to conclude, based on the inscriptions on public buildings, that the people of the lower, older city were Greeks, and those of the modern towns were Italians. However, it would be a hasty conclusion to assume that there was a sudden shift from the Greek to the Italian language in Campania just from this information. But if later he uncovered three buried cities, one on top of the other, the middle one being Roman—while the lowest was Greek and the top one Italian—he would start to see the flaw in his previous thinking. He would begin to think that the disasters that buried the cities might not have anything to do with the changes in the languages spoken by the inhabitants; rather, as the Roman language clearly came between Greek and Italian, many other dialects could have been spoken over time, and the transition from Greek to Italian might have happened gradually, with some words falling out of use while new ones were introduced over time.

If this antiquary could have shown that the volcanic paroxysms of Vesuvius were so governed as that cities should be buried one above the other, just as often as any variation occurred in the language of the inhabitants, then, indeed, the abrupt passage from a Greek to a Roman, and from a Roman to an Italian city, would afford proof of fluctuations no less sudden in the language of the people.

If this historian could have demonstrated that the explosive eruptions of Vesuvius were controlled in a way that cities ended up buried one on top of the other, just as often as there were changes in the language of the locals, then the sudden shift from Greek to Roman, and from Roman to Italian city, would indeed show that the shifts in the language of the people were just as abrupt.

So, in Geology, if we could assume that it is part of the plan of Nature to preserve, in every region of the globe, an unbroken series of monuments to commemorate the vicissitudes of the organic creation, we might infer the sudden extirpation of species, and the simultaneous introduction of others, as often as two formations in contact are found to include dissimilar organic fossils. But we must shut our eyes to the whole economy of the existing causes, aqueous, igneous, and organic, if we fail to perceive that such in not the plan of Nature.

So, in geology, if we could assume that it's part of Nature's plan to maintain an unbroken series of monuments in every region of the world that commemorate the changes in organic life, we could conclude that species can suddenly disappear and be replaced by others whenever two different formations are found together with distinct organic fossils. However, we need to ignore the broader understanding of existing causes—water, fire, and organic processes—if we don’t realize that this is not Nature’s plan.

Concluding remarks on the identity of the ancient and present system of terrestrial changes.—I shall now conclude the discussion of a question with which we have been occupied since the beginning of the fifth chapter; namely, whether there has been any interruption, from the remotest periods, of one uniform system of change in the animate and inanimate world. We were induced to enter into that inquiry by reflecting how much the progress of opinion in Geology had been influenced by the assumption that the analogy was slight in kind, and still more slight in degree, between the causes which produced the former revolutions of the globe, and those now in every-day operation. It appeared clear that the earlier geologists had not only a scanty acquaintance with existing changes, but were singularly unconscious of the amount of their ignorance. With the presumption naturally inspired by this unconsciousness, they had no hesitation in deciding at once that time could never 196 enable the existing powers of nature to work out changes of great magnitude, still less such important revolutions as those which are brought to light by Geology. They, therefore, felt themselves at liberty to indulge their imaginations in guessing at what might be, rather than inquiring what is; in other words, they employed themselves in conjecturing what might have been the course of nature at a remote period, rather than in the investigation of what was the course of nature in their own times.

Concluding remarks on the identity of the ancient and present system of terrestrial changes.—I’ll wrap up the discussion on a question we’ve been tackling since the beginning of the fifth chapter: whether there has been any break, from the earliest times, in one continuous system of change in both the living and non-living world. We started this inquiry by considering how much the development of ideas in Geology has been shaped by the belief that the similarity between the causes of past global changes and those currently at work is minimal, both in kind and in extent. It became apparent that early geologists not only had limited knowledge of present changes but were also remarkably unaware of just how much they didn’t know. With the unearned confidence that comes from this ignorance, they had no qualms about concluding that time could never allow the current forces of nature to generate significant changes, let alone the major upheavals revealed by Geology. Therefore, they felt free to indulge their imaginations in speculating about what might be, rather than investigating what is; in other words, they focused on guessing what the course of nature might have been in the distant past instead of examining what was happening in their own time.

It appeared to them more philosophical to speculate on the possibilities of the past, than patiently to explore the realities of the present; and having invented theories under the influence of such maxims, they were consistently unwilling to test their validity by the criterion of their accordance with the ordinary operations of nature. On the contrary, the claims of each new hypothesis to credibility appeared enhanced by the great contrast, in kind or intensity, of the causes referred to, and those now in operation.

It seemed more intellectual to ponder the possibilities of the past than to patiently investigate the realities of the present. After coming up with theories based on these ideas, they were consistently reluctant to validate them against how nature typically works. Instead, the credibility of each new hypothesis seemed boosted by the stark difference, either in type or strength, between the causes they attributed to it and those currently at play.

Never was there a dogma more calculated to foster indolence, and to blunt the keen edge of curiosity, than this assumption of the discordance between the ancient and existing causes of change. It produced a state of mind unfavorable in the highest degree to the candid reception of the evidence of those minute but incessant alterations which every part of the earth's surface is undergoing, and by which the condition of its living inhabitants is continually made to vary. The student, instead of being encouraged with the hope of interpreting the enigmas presented to him in the earth's structure,—instead of being prompted to undertake laborious inquiries into the natural history of the organic world, and the complicated effects of the igneous and aqueous causes now in operation, was taught to despond from the first. Geology, it was affirmed, could never rise to the rank of an exact science,—the greater number of phenomena must forever remain inexplicable, or only be partially elucidated by ingenious conjectures. Even the mystery which invested the subject was said to constitute one of its principal charms, affording, as it did, full scope to the fancy to indulge in a boundless field of speculation.

Never was there a belief more likely to encourage laziness and dull the edge of curiosity than this idea that there’s a disconnect between ancient causes and current changes. It created a mindset that was extremely unhelpful for openly considering the evidence of the small but constant changes happening across the earth's surface, which continually affect the lives of its inhabitants. Instead of being inspired to solve the puzzles presented by the earth's structure—rather than being motivated to dive into the challenging study of the natural history of living things and the complex impacts of current volcanic and water-related processes—students were made to feel hopeless from the start. It was claimed that geology could never be a precise science; most phenomena would always remain mysterious or only be vaguely explained by clever guesses. Even the mystery surrounding the subject was said to be one of its main attractions, allowing imagination to roam freely in an endless world of speculation.

The course directly opposed to this method of philosophizing consists in an earnest and patient inquiry, how far geological appearances are reconcilable with the effect of changes now in progress, or which may be in progress in regions inaccessible to us, and of which the reality is attested by volcanoes and subterranean movements. It also endeavors to estimate the aggregate result of ordinary operations multiplied by time, and cherishes a sanguine hope that the resources to be derived from observation and experiment, or from the study of nature such as she now is, are very far from-being exhausted. For this reason all theories are rejected which involve the assumption of sudden and violent catastrophes and revolutions of the whole earth, and its inhabitants,—theories which are restrained by no reference to existing analogies, and in which a desire is manifested to cut, rather than patiently to untie, the Gordian knot.

The approach that contrasts with this way of thinking is one that involves serious and patient investigation into how geological features can match the effects of changes happening now, or that might be happening in areas we can't access, which are confirmed by volcanic activity and underground movements. It also tries to assess the total impact of regular processes over time, holding a hopeful belief that the insights we gain from observation, experimentation, or from studying nature as it currently exists, are far from being fully tapped out. For this reason, any theories that depend on sudden, violent disasters and upheavals of the entire earth and its inhabitants are dismissed—these theories don’t relate to current analogies and show a tendency to cut rather than carefully unravel the Gordian knot.

197 We have now, at least, the advantage of knowing, from experience, that an opposite method has always put geologists on the road that leads to truth,—suggesting views which, although imperfect at first, have been found capable of improvement, until at last adopted by universal consent; while the method of speculating on a former distinct state of things and causes, has led invariably to a multitude of contradictory systems, which have been overthrown one after the other,—have been found incapable of modification,—and which have often required to be precisely reversed.

197 We now have the advantage of knowing, from experience, that using the opposite approach has always guided geologists toward the truth. This approach suggests ideas that, while imperfect at first, can be improved over time and eventually gain widespread acceptance. In contrast, speculating about a past, distinct state of things and its causes has consistently resulted in a series of contradictory theories that have been dismantled one by one, proven to be unchangeable, and often requiring a complete reversal.

The remainder of this work will be devoted to an investigation of the changes now going on in the crust of the earth and its inhabitants. The importance which the student will attach to such researches will mainly depend in the degree of confidence which he feels in the principles above expounded. If he firmly believes in the resemblance or identity of the ancient and present system of terrestrial changes, he will regard every fact collected respecting the causes in diurnal action as affording him a key to the interpretation of some mystery in the past. Events which have occurred at the most distant periods in the animate and inanimate world, will be acknowledged to throw light on each other, and the deficiency of our information respecting some of the most obscure parts of the present creation will be removed. For as, by studying the external configuration of the existing land and its inhabitants, we may restore in imagination the appearance of the ancient continents which have passed away, so may we obtain from the deposits of ancient seas and lakes an insight into the nature of the subaqueous processes now in operation, and of many forms of organic life, which, though now existing, are veiled from sight. Rocks, also, produced by subterranean fire in former ages, at great depths in the bowels of the earth, present us, when upraised by gradual movements, and exposed to the light of heaven, with an image of those changes which the deep-seated volcano may now occasion in the nether regions. Thus, although we are mere sojourners on the surface of the planet, chained to a mere point in space, enduring but for a moment of time, the human mind is not only enabled to number worlds beyond the unassisted ken of mortal eye, but to trace the events of indefinite ages before the creation of our race, and is not even withheld from penetrating into the dark secrets of the ocean, or the interior of the solid globe; free, like the spirit which the poet described as animating the universe,

The rest of this work will focus on exploring the changes currently happening in the Earth's crust and its inhabitants. The significance a student places on this research will largely depend on their confidence in the principles outlined earlier. If they strongly believe in the similarities or identity between ancient and present systems of terrestrial changes, they will see every fact gathered about the causes currently at work as a key to understanding some mystery from the past. Events that have taken place in the farthest reaches of both the living and non-living world will be recognized as shedding light on each other, helping to address gaps in our knowledge about some of the more obscure aspects of the present creation. By examining the external features of the existing land and its inhabitants, we can imagine what the former continents that have vanished looked like. Additionally, we can gain insight into the processes currently underway beneath ancient seas and lakes and into various forms of organic life that, while still existing, are hidden from view. Rocks formed by underground fire in past ages, deep within the Earth’s crust, once raised to the surface and exposed to the light, show us the changes that deep-seated volcanoes might currently cause below. Thus, even though we are mere travelers on the surface of this planet, tied to a single point in space and enduring only for a brief time, the human mind can not only count worlds beyond the unaided eye but also trace events from countless ages before humanity existed. It can even delve into the deep mysteries of the ocean or the interior of the solid Earth; free, like the spirit the poet described as animating the universe.

Fire for all Terrasque, tractusque mari, cœlum profundo.

BOOK II.

CHANGES IN THE INORGANIC WORLD.
AQUEOUS CAUSES.

CHAPTER XIV.

Division of the subject into changes of the organic and inorganic world—Inorganic causes of change divided into aqueous and igneous—Aqueous causes first considered—Fall of rain—Recent rain-prints in mud—Destroying and transporting power of running water—Newly formed valleys in Georgia—Sinuosities of rivers—Two streams when united do not occupy a bed of double surface—Inundations in Scotland—Floods caused by landslips in the White Mountains—Bursting of a lake in Switzerland—Devastations caused by the Anio at Tivoli—Excavations in the lavas of Etna by Sicilian rivers—Gorge of the Simeto—Gradual recession of the cataract of Niagara.

Division of the topic into changes in the organic and inorganic worlds—Inorganic causes of change are split into water-related and fire-related—Water-related causes will be discussed first—Fall of rain—Recent rain marks in mud—The destruction and transportation power of flowing water—Newly formed valleys in Georgia—Curves of rivers—When two streams join, they don’t create a bed with double the surface—Flooding events in Scotland—Floods caused by landslides in the White Mountains—The bursting of a lake in Switzerland—Destruction caused by the Anio River at Tivoli—Erosion in the lavas of Etna by Sicilian rivers—Gorge of the Simeto—The gradual retreat of the Niagara Falls.

Division of the subject.—Geology was defined to be the science which investigates the former changes that have taken place in the organic as well as in the inorganic kingdoms of nature. As vicissitudes in the inorganic world are most apparent, and as on them all fluctuations in the animate creation must in a great measure depend, they may claim our first consideration. The great agents of change in the inorganic world may be divided into two principal classes, the aqueous and the igneous. To the aqueous belong Rain, Rivers, Torrents, Springs, Currents, and Tides; to the igneous, Volcanoes, and Earthquakes. Both these classes are instruments of decay as well as of reproduction; but they may also be regarded as antagonist forces. For the aqueous agents are incessantly laboring to reduce the inequalities of the earth's surface to a level; while the igneous are equally active in restoring the unevenness of the external crust, partly by heaping up new matter in certain localities, and partly by depressing one portion, and forcing out another, of the earth's envelope.

Division of the subject.—Geology is defined as the science that examines the past changes in both the organic and inorganic realms of nature. Since changes in the inorganic world are most visible, and since all variations in living organisms largely depend on them, they deserve our primary attention. The main forces of change in the inorganic world can be divided into two main categories: aqueous and igneous. The aqueous category includes Rain, Rivers, Torrents, Springs, Currents, and Tides; the igneous category includes Volcanoes and Earthquakes. Both classes serve as agents of decay and renewal; however, they can also be seen as opposing forces. The aqueous agents continuously work to flatten the unevenness of the earth’s surface, while the igneous agents are equally active in restoring that unevenness, partly by adding new material in certain areas and partly by lowering one section and pushing up another part of the earth’s crust.

It is difficult, in a scientific arrangement, to give an accurate view of the combined effects of so many forces in simultaneous operation; because, when we consider them separately, we cannot easily estimate either the extent of their efficacy, or the kind of results which they produce. We are in danger, therefore, when we attempt to examine the influence exerted singly by each, of overlooking the modifications which they produce on one another; and these are so complicated, that sometimes the igneous and aqueous forces co-operate to produce a joint effect, to which neither of them unaided by the other could 199 give rise,—as when repeated earthquakes unite with running water to widen a valley; or when a thermal spring rises up from a great depth, and conveys the mineral ingredients with which it is impregnated from the interior of the earth to the surface. Sometimes the organic combine with the inorganic causes; as when a reef, composed of shells and corals, protects one line of coast from the destroying power of tides or currents, and turns them against some other point; or when drift timber, floated into a lake, fills a hollow to which the stream would not have had sufficient velocity to convey earthy sediment.

It’s challenging, in a scientific framework, to accurately capture the combined effects of so many forces acting at the same time. When we look at them individually, it’s hard to gauge how effective they are or what kinds of results they produce. Therefore, when we try to analyze the influence of each one separately, we risk missing the ways they interact with one another. These interactions are so complex that sometimes fiery and watery forces work together to create an outcome that neither could achieve alone—like when repeated earthquakes combined with flowing water widen a valley, or when a thermal spring rises from deep within the earth, bringing mineral-rich water to the surface. At times, organic forces mix with inorganic ones, like when a reef made of shells and corals shields a coastline from the destructive power of tides or currents, redirecting them to another spot; or when driftwood ends up in a lake, filling a depression that the stream wouldn’t have been able to fill because it lacked enough speed to carry sediment.

It is necessary, however, to divide our observations on these various causes, and to classify them systematically, endeavoring as much as possible to keep in view that the effects in nature are mixed and not simple, as they may appear in an artificial arrangement.

It’s important, though, to break down our observations on these different causes and to organize them systematically, trying as much as possible to remember that the effects in nature are complex and not straightforward, even if they might seem simple in an artificial setup.

In treating, in the first place, of the aqueous causes, we may consider them under two divisions; first, those which are connected with the circulation of water from the land to the sea, under which are included all the phenomena of rain, rivers, glaciers, and springs; secondly, those which arise from the movements of water in lakes, seas, and the ocean, wherein are comprised the phenomena of waves, tides, and currents. In turning our attention to the former division, we find that the effects of rivers may be subdivided into, first, those of a destroying and transporting, and, secondly, those of a renovating nature; in the former are included the erosion of rocks and the transportation of matter to lower levels; in the renovating class, the formation of deltas by the influx of sediment, and the shallowing of seas; but these processes are so intimately related to each other, that it will not always be possible to consider them under their separate heads.

When discussing the water-related causes, we can think of them in two categories: first, those connected to the flow of water from land to sea, which includes all the phenomena of rain, rivers, glaciers, and springs; second, those that arise from the movement of water in lakes, seas, and oceans, which encompass waves, tides, and currents. Looking at the first category, we see that the effects of rivers can be divided into two parts: first, those that are destructive and transportative, and second, those that are restorative. The destructive and transportative effects include the erosion of rocks and the movement of materials to lower levels; in the restorative category, we find the formation of deltas due to sediment influx and the shallowing of seas. However, these processes are so closely connected that it isn’t always feasible to examine them separately.

Fall of Rain.—It is well known that the capacity of the atmosphere to absorb aqueous vapor, and hold it in suspension, increases with every increment of temperature. This capacity is also found to augment in a higher ratio than the augmentation of the heat. Hence, as was first suggested by the geologist, Dr. Hutton, when two volumes of air, of different temperatures, both saturated with moisture, mingle together, clouds and rain are produced, for a mean degree of heat having resulted from the union of the two moist airs, the excess of vapor previously held in suspension by the warmer of the two is given out, and if it be in sufficient abundance is precipitated in the form of rain.

Fall of Rain.—It's well known that the atmosphere's ability to absorb water vapor and keep it suspended increases with temperature. This ability actually grows at a faster rate than the increase in heat. Therefore, as first proposed by the geologist Dr. Hutton, when two volumes of air at different temperatures, both saturated with moisture, mix together, clouds and rain form. This happens because a mean temperature results from the combination of the two moist air masses, and the excess vapor that the warmer air was holding gets released. If there's enough of it, this vapor falls as rain.

As the temperature of the atmosphere diminishes gradually from the equator towards the pole, the evaporation of water and the quantity of rain diminish also. According to Humboldt's computation, the average annual depth of rain at the equator is 96 inches, while in lat. 45° it is only 29 inches, and in lat. 60° not more than 17 inches. But there are so many disturbing causes, that the actual discharge, in any given locality, may deviate very widely from this rule. In England, for example, where the average fall at London is 24½ inches, as ascertained at the Greenwich Observatory, there is such irregularity in some districts, 200 that while at Whitehaven, in Cumberland, there fell in 1849, 32 inches, the quantity of rain in Borrowdale, near Keswick (only 15 miles to the westward), was no less than 142 inches!262 In like manner, in India, Colonel Sykes found by observations made in 1847 and 1848, that at places situated between 17° and 18° north lat., on a line drawn across the Western Ghauts in the Deccan, the fall of rain varied from 21 to 219 inches.263 The annual average in Bengal is probably below 80 inches, yet Dr. G. Hooker witnessed at Churrapoonjee, in the year 1850, a fall of 30 inches in 24 hours, and in the same place during a residence of six months (from June to November) 530 inches! This occurred on the south face of the Khasia (or Garrow) mountains in Eastern Bengal (see map, Chap. XVIII.), where the depth during the whole of the same year probably exceeded 600 inches. So extraordinary a discharge of water, which, as we shall presently see, is very local, may be thus accounted for. Warm, southerly winds, blowing over the Bay of Bengal, and becoming laden with vapor during their passage, reach the low level delta of the Ganges and Brahmapootra, where the ordinary heat exceeds that of the sea, and where evaporation is constantly going on from countless marshes and the arms of the great rivers. A mingling of two masses of damp air of different temperatures probably causes the fall of 70 or 80 inches of rain, which takes place on the plains. The monsoon having crossed the delta, impinges on the Khasia mountains, which rise abruptly from the plain to a mean elevation of between 4000 and 5000 feet. Here the wind not only encounters the cold air of the mountains, but, what is far more effective as a refrigerating cause, the aerial current is made to flow upwards, and to ascend to a height of several thousand feet above the sea. Both the air and the vapor contained in it, being thus relieved of much atmospheric pressure, expand suddenly, and are cooled by rarefaction. The vapor is condensed, and about 500 inches of rain are thrown down annually, nearly twenty times as much as falls in Great Britain in a year, and almost all of it poured down in six months. The channel of every torrent and river is swollen at this season, and much sandstone horizontally stratified, and other rocks are reduced to sand and gravel by the flooded streams. So great is the superficial waste (or denudation), that what would otherwise be a rich and luxuriantly wooded region, is converted into a wild and barren moorland.

As the temperature of the atmosphere gradually decreases from the equator toward the poles, the evaporation of water and the amount of rainfall also decline. According to Humboldt's calculations, the average annual rainfall at the equator is 96 inches, while at latitude 45° it drops to only 29 inches, and at latitude 60°, it’s just 17 inches. However, there are so many influencing factors that actual rainfall in any specific area can vary widely from this pattern. In England, for instance, the average rainfall in London is 24½ inches, as measured at the Greenwich Observatory, but there are significant discrepancies in some regions. For example, in 1849, Whitehaven, in Cumberland, received 32 inches of rain, while in Borrowdale, near Keswick (only 15 miles to the west), it rained an astonishing 142 inches! In India, Colonel Sykes found through observations made in 1847 and 1848 that at locations between 17° and 18° north latitude, along a line crossing the Western Ghats in the Deccan, rainfall varied from 21 to 219 inches. The annual average in Bengal is likely below 80 inches, yet Dr. G. Hooker recorded 30 inches of rain in just 24 hours at Churrapoonjee in 1850, and during a six-month stay (from June to November), 530 inches fell! This happened on the south side of the Khasia (or Garrow) mountains in Eastern Bengal (see Chapter XVIII), where the total for the year likely exceeded 600 inches. Such an extraordinary amount of rainfall, which we'll see is very localized, can be explained. Warm, south winds blowing over the Bay of Bengal become saturated with moisture as they travel and arrive at the low delta of the Ganges and Brahmaputra, where the usual temperature exceeds that of the sea and evaporation constantly occurs from many marshes and river branches. The interaction of two masses of humid air at different temperatures likely leads to the 70 or 80 inches of rain that falls on the plains. After crossing the delta, the monsoon hits the Khasia mountains, which rise sharply from the plain to an average height of 4,000 to 5,000 feet. Here, the wind not only meets the colder mountain air, but what’s even more effective in cooling is that the air is forced to rise to several thousand feet above sea level. Both the air and the moisture in it, experiencing a reduction in atmospheric pressure, expand quickly and cool due to rarefaction. The moisture condenses, resulting in about 500 inches of rain annually—nearly twenty times more than what falls in Great Britain in a year, and almost all of it occurs within six months. During this season, every stream and river swells, and much horizontally layered sandstone and other rocks are worn down to sand and gravel by the rushing waters. The amount of surface erosion (or denudation) is so significant that what would typically be a rich, lush forest area turns into a wild and barren moorland.

After the current of warm air has been thus drained of a large portion of its moisture, it still continues its northerly course to the opposite flank of the Khasia range, only 20 miles farther north, and here the fall of rain is reduced to 70 inches in the year. The same wind then blows northwards across the valley of the Brahmapootra, and at length arrives so dry and exhausted at the Bhootan Himalaya (lat. 28° N.), that those mountains, up to the height of 5000 feet, are naked and sterile, and all their outer valleys arid and dusty. The aerial current still continuing 201 its northerly course and ascending to a higher region, becomes further cooled, condensation again ensues, and Bhootan, above 5000 feet, is densely clothed with vegetation.264

After the warm air has lost much of its moisture, it continues to move north toward the other side of the Khasia range, just 20 miles farther north, where the annual rainfall drops to 70 inches. The same wind then blows north across the Brahmaputra valley and eventually reaches the Bhutan Himalayas (lat. 28° N.) so dry and depleted that the mountains up to 5000 feet are bare and lifeless, with all their outer valleys being dry and dusty. As the air current keeps moving north and rises to a higher altitude, it gets even cooler, causing condensation to happen again, and above 5000 feet in Bhutan, the area is richly covered with vegetation.201

In another part of India, immediately to the westward, similar phenomena are repeated. The same warm and humid winds, copiously charged with aqueous vapor from the Bay of Bengal, hold their course due north for 300 miles across the flat and hot plains of the Ganges, till they encounter the lofty Sikkim mountains. (See map, Chap. XVIII.) On the southern flank of these they discharge such a deluge of rain that the rivers in the rainy season rise twelve feet in as many hours. Numerous landslips, some of them extending three or four thousand feet along the face of the mountains, composed of granite, gneiss, and slate, descend into the beds of streams, and dam them up for a time, causing temporary lakes, which soon burst their barriers. "Day and night," says Dr. Hooker, "we heard the crashing of falling trees, and the sound of boulders thrown violently against each other in the beds of torrents. By such wear and tear rocky fragments swept down from the hills are in part converted into sand and fine mud; and the turbid Ganges, during its annual inundation, derives more of its sediment from this source than from the waste of the fine clay of the alluvial plains below.265

In another part of India, directly to the west, similar events are taking place. The same warm and humid winds, heavily filled with water vapor from the Bay of Bengal, travel north for 300 miles across the flat and hot plains of the Ganges until they reach the high Sikkim mountains. (See map, Chap. XVIII.) On the southern side of these mountains, they release such a downpour that the rivers rise twelve feet in just a few hours during the rainy season. Numerous landslides, some extending three or four thousand feet along the mountains made of granite, gneiss, and slate, flow into the riverbeds, temporarily blocking them and creating temporary lakes that eventually overflow. "Day and night," Dr. Hooker remarks, "we heard the crashing of falling trees and the sound of boulders violently colliding in the torrent beds. Through this process, rocky fragments swept down from the hills are partially turned into sand and fine mud; and the muddy Ganges, during its annual flood, gets more of its sediment from this rather than from the erosion of the fine clay of the alluvial plains below.265

On the verge of the tropics a greater quantity of rain falls annually than at the equator. Yet parts even of the tropical latitudes are entirely destitute of rain: Peru, for example, which owes its vegetation solely to rivers and nightly dews. In that country easterly winds prevail, blowing from the Pacific, and these being intercepted by the Andes, and cooled as they rise, are made to part with all their moisture before reaching the low region to the leeward. The desert zone of North Africa, between lat. 15° and 30° N., is another instance of a rainless region. Five or six consecutive years may pass in Upper Egypt, Nubia, and Dongola, or in the Desert of Sahara, without rain.

On the edge of the tropics, more rain falls each year than at the equator. However, some areas within the tropical latitudes have almost no rainfall at all. For instance, Peru gets its vegetation only from rivers and nightly dew. In that country, easterly winds blow in from the Pacific, and as they rise and are blocked by the Andes, they lose all their moisture before reaching the lower areas on the other side. Another example of a region without rain is the desert zone of North Africa, between 15° and 30° N latitude. In Upper Egypt, Nubia, Dongola, or the Sahara Desert, it’s possible to go five or six consecutive years without any rain.

From the facts above mentioned, the reader will infer that in the course of successive geological periods there will be great variations in the quantity of rain falling in one and the same region. At one time there may be none whatever during the whole year; at another a fall of 100 or 500 inches; and these two last averages may occur on the two opposite flanks of a mountain-chain, not more than 20 miles wide. While, therefore, the valleys in one district are widened and deepened annually, they may remain stationary in another, the superficial soil being protected from waste by a dense covering of vegetation. This diversity depends on many geographical circumstances, but principally on the height of the land above the sea, the direction of the prevailing winds, and the relative position, at the time being, of the plains, hills, and the ocean, conditions all of which are liable in the course of ages to undergo a complete revolution.

Based on the facts mentioned above, the reader can deduce that over different geological periods, there will be significant variations in the amount of rainfall in the same region. At one time, there might be no rain at all for the entire year; at another, there could be 100 or 500 inches of rain, with these two averages possibly occurring on opposite sides of a mountain range that’s only about 20 miles wide. Thus, while valleys in one area may become wider and deeper every year, they might stay the same in another area, where the topsoil is protected from erosion by a thick layer of vegetation. This variation depends on many geographical factors, but mainly on the elevation of the land above sea level, the direction of the prevailing winds, and the current positions of the plains, hills, and ocean—conditions that are all likely to change significantly over time.

202 Recent rain-prints.—When examining, in 1842, the extensive mud-flats of Nova Scotia, which are exposed at low tide on the borders of the Bay of Fundy, I observed not only the foot-prints of birds which had recently passed over the mud, but also very distinct impressions of rain-drops. A peculiar combination of circumstances renders these mud-flats admirably fitted to receive and retain any markings which may happen to be made on their surface. The sediment with which the waters are charged is extremely fine, being derived from the destruction of cliffs of red sandstone and shale, and as the tides rise fifty feet and upwards, large areas are laid dry for nearly a fortnight between the spring and neap tides. In this interval the mud is baked in summer by a hot sun, so that it solidifies and becomes traversed by cracks, caused by shrinkage. Portions of the hardened mud between these cracks may then be taken up and removed without injury. On examining the edges of each slab, we observe numerous layers, formed by successive tides, each layer being usually very thin, sometimes only one-tenth of an inch thick. When a shower of rain falls, the highest portion of the mud-covered flat is usually too hard to receive any impressions; while that recently uncovered by the tide near the water's edge is too soft. Between these areas a zone occurs, almost as smooth and even as a looking-glass, on which every drop forms a cavity of circular or oval form, and, if the shower be transient, these pits retain their shape permanently, being dried by the sun, and being then too firm to be effaced by the action of the succeeding tide, which deposits upon them a new layer of mud. Hence we often find, in splitting open a slab an inch or more thick, on the upper surface of which the marks of recent rain occur, that an inferior layer, deposited during some previous rise of the tide, exhibits on its under side perfect casts of rain-prints, which stand out in relief, the moulds of the same being seen on the layer below. But in some cases, especially in the more sandy layers, the markings have been somewhat blunted by the tide, and by several rain-prints having been joined into one by a repetition of drops falling on the same spot; in which case the casts present a very irregular and blistered appearance.

202 Recent rain-prints.—When I looked at the vast mud-flats of Nova Scotia in 1842, which are exposed at low tide along the Bay of Fundy, I noticed not only the footprints of birds that had just walked over the mud but also clear impressions of raindrops. A unique combination of circumstances makes these mud-flats ideal for capturing and holding any markings made on their surface. The sediment in the water is extremely fine, coming from eroded cliffs of red sandstone and shale, and since the tides can rise over fifty feet, large areas dry out for almost two weeks between the spring and neap tides. During this time, the mud gets baked in the summer sun, solidifying and cracking due to shrinkage. Pieces of the hardened mud between these cracks can then be lifted and removed without damage. When we check the edges of each slab, we see many layers formed by successive tides, with each layer typically being very thin, sometimes only a tenth of an inch thick. After a rain shower, the highest part of the mud-covered flat is usually too hard to leave impressions, while the area just uncovered by the tide near the water's edge is too soft. Between these areas, there's a zone that’s almost as smooth and even as a mirror, where every raindrop creates a circular or oval cavity, and if the shower is brief, these pits hold their shape permanently, drying in the sun and becoming too firm to be wiped away by the next tide, which deposits a new layer of mud on top of them. Thus, we often find that when splitting open a slab that’s an inch or more thick, with raindrop marks on the upper surface, the lower layer—deposited during a previous tide rise—shows perfect casts of rain-prints underneath, visible in relief, with molds of the same on the layer below. However, in some cases, especially in sandier layers, the impressions have been somewhat smoothed out by the tide, and multiple raindrops falling in the same spot may blend into one, making the casts look very irregular and blistered.

The finest examples which I have seen of these rain-prints were sent to me by Dr. Webster, from Kentville, on the borders of the Bay of Mines, in Nova Scotia. They were made by a heavy shower which fell on the 21st of July, 1849, when the rise and fall of the tides were at their maximum. The impressions (see fig. 13) consist of cup-shaped or hemispherical cavities, the average size of which is from one-eighth to one-tenth of an inch across, but the largest are fully half an inch in diameter, and one-tenth of an inch deep. The depth is chiefly below the general surface or plane of stratification, but the walls of the cavity consist partly of a prominent rim of sandy mud, formed of the matter which has been forcibly expelled from the pit. All the cavities having an oval form are deeper at one end, where they have also a higher rim, and all the deep ends have the same direction, showing towards which 203 quarter the wind was blowing. Two or more drops are sometimes seen to have interfered with each other; in which case it is usually possible to determine which drop fell last, its rim being unbroken.

The best examples I've seen of these rain prints were sent to me by Dr. Webster from Kentville, on the edge of the Bay of Mines in Nova Scotia. They were created by a heavy shower that fell on July 21, 1849, when the tides were at their highest. The impressions (see fig. 13) consist of cup-shaped or hemispherical cavities, with an average size of about one-eighth to one-tenth of an inch across. However, the largest ones are about half an inch in diameter and one-tenth of an inch deep. Most of the depth is below the general surface or plane of stratification, but the walls of the cavity include a noticeable rim of sandy mud, made of the material that was forcefully pushed out from the pit. All the cavities that have an oval shape are deeper at one end, where they also have a higher rim, and all the deeper ends point in the same direction, indicating where the wind was blowing from. Occasionally, two or more drops appear to have interacted; in such cases, it’s usually possible to identify which drop fell last, as its rim remains unbroken.

Fig. 13.Recent rain-prints.

Recent rain-prints, formed July 21, 1849, at Kentville, Bay of Fundy, Nova Scotia.
The arrow represents the direction of the shower.

Recent rain impressions, formed on July 21, 1849, at Kentville, Bay of Fundy, Nova Scotia.
The arrow indicates the direction of the shower.

On some of the specimens the winding tubular tracks of worms are seen, which have been bored just beneath the surface (see fig. 13, left side). They occasionally pass under the middle of a rain-mark, having been formed subsequently. Sometimes the worms have dived beneath the surface, and then reappeared. All these appearances, both of rain-prints and worm-tracks, are of great geological interest, as their exact counterparts are seen in rocks of various ages, even in formations of very high antiquity.266 Small cavities, often corresponding in size to those produced by rain, are also caused by air-bubbles rising up through sand or mud; but these differ in character from rain-prints, being usually deeper than they are wide, and having their sides steeper. These, indeed, are occasionally vertical, or overarching, the opening at the top being narrower than the pit below. In their mode, also, of mutual interference they are unlike rain-prints.267

On some of the specimens, you can see the winding tubular tracks of worms that have been burrowed just beneath the surface (see fig. 13, left side). They sometimes go under the center of a rain mark, having formed afterward. Occasionally, the worms dive beneath the surface and then come back up. All these signs, both rain prints and worm tracks, are of great geological interest because their exact counterparts can be found in rocks from various ages, even in formations that are very ancient.266 Small cavities, often matching the size of those created by rain, are also formed by air bubbles rising through sand or mud; however, these differ from rain prints in that they are usually deeper than wide, with steeper sides. In fact, some of them can be vertical or arching, with the opening at the top being narrower than the pit below. Their patterns of mutual interference are also different from rain prints.267

In consequence of the effects of mountains in cooling currents of moist air, and causing the condensation of aqueous vapor in the manner above described, it follows that in every country, as a general rule, the more elevated regions become perpetual reservoirs of water, which descends and irrigates the lower valleys and plains. The largest quantity of water is first carried to the highest region, and then made to descend by steep declivities towards the sea; so that it acquires superior velocity, and removes more soil, than it would do if the rain had been distributed over the plains and mountains equally in proportion to their relative 204 areas. The water is also made by these means to pass over the greatest distances before it can regain the sea.

As a result of mountains influencing the cooling of moist air currents and causing water vapor to condense as described above, it's generally true that in every country, higher elevations become constant sources of water, which flows down and irrigates the lower valleys and plains. The largest amount of water is initially collected at the highest points and then channels down steep slopes toward the sea, gaining speed and eroding more soil than it would if the rain were evenly spread across the plains and mountains according to their respective areas. This process also allows the water to travel the longest distances before it returns to the sea.

It has already been observed that in higher latitudes, where the atmosphere being colder is capable of holding less water in suspension, a diminished fall of rain takes place. Thus at St. Petersburg, the amount is only 16 inches, and at Uleaborg in the Gulf of Bothnia (N. lat. 65°), only 13½ inches, or less than half the average of England, and even this small quantity descends more slowly in the temperate zone, and is spread more equally over the year than in tropical climates. But in reference to geological changes, frost in the colder latitude acts as a compensating power in the disintegration of rocks, and the transportation of stones to lower levels.

It has already been noted that in higher latitudes, where the colder atmosphere holds less water in the air, there is less rainfall. For example, in St. Petersburg, the average is only 16 inches, and in Uleaborg in the Gulf of Bothnia (N. lat. 65°), it’s just 13½ inches, which is less than half the average in England. Even this small amount of rainfall occurs more slowly in the temperate zone and is distributed more evenly throughout the year compared to tropical climates. However, regarding geological changes, frost in colder regions helps break down rocks and move stones to lower elevations.

Water when converted into ice augments in bulk more than one-twentieth of its volume, and owing to this property it widens the minute crevices (or joints) of rocks into which it penetrates. Ice also in various ways, as will be shown in the next chapter, gives buoyancy to mud and sand, even to huge blocks of stone, enabling rivers of moderate size and velocity to carry them to a great distance.

Water, when it turns into ice, expands by more than one-twentieth of its volume. Because of this property, it widens the tiny cracks (or joints) in rocks that it seeps into. Ice also, in several ways as will be explained in the next chapter, helps lift mud and sand, even large stones, allowing rivers of moderate size and speed to transport them over long distances.

The mechanical force exerted by running water in undermining cliffs, and rounding off the angles of hard rock, is mainly due to the intermixture of foreign ingredients. Sand and pebbles, when hurried along by the violence of the stream, are thrown against every obstacle lying in their way, and thus a power of attrition is acquired, capable of wearing through the hardest siliceous stones, on which water alone could make no impression.

The mechanical force created by flowing water when it erodes cliffs and smooths the edges of hard rock is mostly due to the mix of different materials. Sand and pebbles, when swept along by the force of the current, collide with every obstacle in their path, gaining the ability to wear down even the toughest siliceous stones that water alone couldn't affect.

Newly formed valleys.—When travelling in Georgia and Alabama, in 1846, I saw in both those States the commencement of hundreds of valleys in places where the native forest had recently been removed. One of these newly formed gulleys or ravines is represented in the annexed woodcut (fig. 14), from a drawing which I made on the spot. It occurs three miles and a half due west of Milledgeville, the capital of Georgia, and is situated on the farm of Pomona, on the direct road to Macon.268

Newly formed valleys.—While traveling in Georgia and Alabama in 1846, I noticed the beginnings of hundreds of valleys in areas where the native forest had recently been cleared. One of these newly formed gullies or ravines is shown in the woodcut (fig. 14), based on a drawing I made on site. It is located three and a half miles directly west of Milledgeville, the capital of Georgia, and can be found on the Pomona farm along the main road to Macon.268

Twenty years ago, before the land was cleared, it had no existence; but when the trees of the forest were cut down, cracks three feet deep were caused by the sun's heat in the clay; and, during the rains, a sudden rush of water through the principal crack deepened it at its lower extremity, from whence the excavating power worked backwards, till, in the course of twenty years, a chasm, measuring no less than 55 feet in depth, 300 yards in length, and varying in width from 20 to 180 feet, was the result. The high road has been several times turned to avoid this cavity, the enlargement of which is still proceeding, and the old line of road may be seen to have held its course directly over what is now the wildest part of the ravine. In the perpendicular walls of this great chasm appear beds of clay and sand, red, white, yellow, and green, produced by the decomposition in situ of hornblendic gneiss, with layers and veins of quartz, which remain entire, to prove that the whole mass was once solid and crystalline.

Twenty years ago, before the land was cleared, it didn't exist; but when the trees of the forest were cut down, the sun's heat caused cracks three feet deep in the clay. During the rains, a sudden rush of water through the main crack deepened it at the bottom, where the erosion worked backward, resulting in a chasm that, over twenty years, grew to be 55 feet deep, 300 yards long, and varied in width from 20 to 180 feet. The main road has been redirected several times to avoid this pit, which is still expanding, and the old road can be seen running directly over what is now the wildest part of the ravine. In the steep walls of this massive chasm, there are layers of clay and sand—red, white, yellow, and green—created by the breakdown of hornblendic gneiss, with complete layers and veins of quartz remaining to show that the whole mass was once solid and crystalline.

Fig. 14.Ravine on the farm of Pomona.

Ravine on the farm of Pomona, near Milledgeville, Georgia, as it appeared January, 1846. Excavated in twenty years, 55 feet deep, and 180 feet broad.

Ravine on the farm of Pomona, near Milledgeville, Georgia, as it appeared in January 1846. Excavated over twenty years, 55 feet deep, and 180 feet wide.

I infer, from the rapidity of the denudation which only began here after the removal of the native wood, that this spot, elevated about 600 feet above the sea, has been always covered with a dense forest, from the remote time when it first emerged from the sea. The termination of the cavity on the right hand in the foreground is the head or upper end of the ravine, and in almost every case, such gulleys are lengthened by the streams cutting their way backwards. The depth at the upper end is often, as in this case, considerable, and there is usually at this point, during floods, a small cascade.

I can tell from how quickly the area has eroded since the native woods were cleared that this location, about 600 feet above sea level, has always been covered in thick forest since it first rose from the ocean. The end of the hollow on the right in the foreground marks the top of the ravine, and typically, these types of gullies extend as the streams carve their way backward. The depth at the top is often significant, as it is here, and there's usually a small waterfall at this spot during floods.

Sinuosities of rivers.—In proportion as such valleys are widened, sinuosities are caused by the deflection of the stream first to one side 206 and then to the other. The unequal hardness of the materials through which the channel is eroded tends partly to give new directions to the lateral force of excavation. When by these, or by accidental shiftings of the alluvial matter in the channel, the current is made to cross its general line of descent, it eats out a curve in the opposite bank, or in the side of the hills bounding the valley, from which curve it is turned back again at an equal angle, so that it recrosses the line of descent, and gradually hollows out another curve lower down in the opposite bank, till the whole sides of the valley, or river bed, present a succession of salient and retiring angles. Among the causes of deviation from a straight course, by which torrents and rivers tend in mountainous regions to widen the valleys through which they flow, may be mentioned the confluence of lateral torrents, swollen irregularly at different seasons by partial storms, and discharging at different times unequal quantities of sand, mud, and pebbles, into the main channel.

Sinuosities of rivers.—As valleys widen, the twists in the river are created by the stream shifting first to one side 206 and then to the other. The varying hardness of the materials that the channel wears away influences the direction of the lateral erosion. When, due to these factors or random shifts of sediment in the channel, the current crosses its usual downward path, it carves out a curve in the opposite bank or in the hills along the valley. This curve then redirects the flow at an equal angle, causing it to cross back over the original path and gradually create another curve further down in the opposite bank. This process results in the valley or riverbed displaying a series of protruding and receding angles. Among the reasons for the deviations from a straight flow, which cause torrents and rivers to widen valleys in mountainous areas, are the merging of side streams that swell at different times due to localized storms, releasing varying amounts of sand, mud, and pebbles into the main channel.

Fig. 15.Tortuous flexures of a river.

When the tortuous flexures of a river are extremely great, as often happens in alluvial plains, the aberration from the direct line of descent may be restored by the river cutting through the isthmus which separates two neighboring curves. Thus in the annexed diagram, the extreme sinuosity of the river has caused it to return for a brief space in a contrary direction to its main course, so that a peninsula is formed, and the isthmus (at a) is consumed on both sides by currents flowing in opposite directions. In this case an island is soon formed,—on either side of which a portion of the stream usually remains.

When the twists and turns of a river are really sharp, like often happens in floodplains, the river can make a shortcut by cutting through the narrow land that separates two nearby bends. In the attached diagram, the river's extreme winding has caused it to briefly flow back in the opposite direction of its main path, creating a peninsula, while the narrow land (at a) is eroded on both sides by currents flowing in different directions. In this situation, an island quickly forms, usually leaving part of the stream on either side of it.

Transporting power of water.—In regard to the transporting power of water, we may often be surprised at the facility with which streams of a small size, and descending a slight declivity, bear along coarse sand and gravel; for we usually estimate the weight of rocks in air, and do not reflect on their comparative buoyancy when submerged in a denser fluid. The specific gravity of many rocks is not more than twice that of water, and very rarely more than thrice, so that almost all the fragments propelled by a stream have lost a third, and many of them a half, of what we usually term their weight.

Transporting power of water.—When it comes to the transporting power of water, we can often be amazed at how easily small streams, flowing down a gentle slope, carry coarse sand and gravel. This happens because we usually think about the weight of rocks in the air and don’t consider how much lighter they become when they are submerged in a denser fluid. The specific gravity of many rocks is not more than twice that of water, and it’s very rare for it to be more than three times, so almost all the pieces moved by a stream have lost a third of what we typically call their weight, and many have lost half.

It has been proved by experiment, in contradiction to the theories of the earlier writers on hydrostatics, to be a universal law, regulating the motion of running water, that the velocity at the bottom of the stream is everywhere less than in any part above it, and is greatest at the surface. Also that the superficial particles in the middle of the stream move swifter than those at the sides. This retardation of the lowest and lateral currents is produced by friction; and when the velocity is sufficiently great, the soil composing the sides and bottom 207 gives way. A velocity of three inches per second at the bottom is ascertained to be sufficient to tear up fine clay,—six inches per second, fine sand,—twelve inches per second, fine gravel,—and three feet per second, stones of the size of an egg.269

It has been proven through experiments, contrary to the theories of earlier writers on hydrostatics, to be a universal law governing the flow of running water that the velocity at the bottom of the stream is always less than at any point above it, with the highest speed occurring at the surface. Additionally, the particles on the surface in the middle of the stream move faster than those at the edges. This slowing down of the flow at the bottom and sides is caused by friction; and when the speed is high enough, the soil that makes up the sides and bottom 207 starts to give way. A speed of three inches per second at the bottom has been found to be enough to dislodge fine clay, six inches per second for fine sand, twelve inches per second for fine gravel, and three feet per second for stones the size of an egg.269

When this mechanical power of running water is considered, we are prepared for the transportation before alluded to of large quantities of gravel, sand, and mud, by torrents which descend from mountainous regions. But a question naturally arises, How the more tranquil rivers of the valleys and plains, flowing on comparatively level ground, can remove the prodigious burden which is discharged into them by their numerous tributaries, and by what means they are enabled to convey the whole mass to the sea? If they had not this removing power, their channels would be annually choked up, and the valleys of the lower country, and plains at the base of mountain-chains, would be continually strewed over with fragments of rock and sterile sand. But this evil is prevented by a general law regulating the conduct of running water,—that two equal streams do not, when united, occupy a bed of double surface. Nay, the width of the principal river, after the junction of a tributary, sometimes remains the same as before, or is even lessened. The cause of this apparent paradox was long ago explained by the Italian writers, who had studied the confluence of the Po and its feeders in the plains of Lombardy.

When we think about the mechanical power of flowing water, it sets the stage for the transportation of large amounts of gravel, sand, and mud carried by torrents from mountainous areas. However, a question naturally comes to mind: How do the calmer rivers in valleys and plains, moving across relatively flat ground, manage to carry away the massive load deposited by their many tributaries, and how do they get all that material to the sea? If these rivers didn’t have this ability to remove excess material, their channels would get clogged every year, and the valleys and lowlands at the foot of mountains would be constantly covered with rock fragments and barren sand. Fortunately, this issue is avoided by a fundamental principle governing the behavior of flowing water—two equal streams, when combined, don’t fill a bed that’s twice the size. In fact, the width of the main river after a tributary joins it sometimes stays the same, or even decreases. The reason behind this seeming contradiction was explained a long time ago by Italian scholars who studied the meeting of the Po River and its tributaries in the plains of Lombardy.

The addition of a smaller river augments the velocity of the main stream, often in the same proportion as it does the quantity of water. Thus the Venetian branch of the Po swallowed up the Ferranese branch and that of Panaro without any enlargement of its own dimensions. The cause of the greater velocity is, first, that after the union of two rivers the water, in place of the friction of four shores, has only that of two to surmount; 2dly, because the main body of the stream being farther distant from the banks, flows on with less interruption; and lastly, because a greater quantity of water moving more swiftly, digs deeper into the river's bed. By this beautiful adjustment, the water which drains the interior country is made continually to occupy less room as it approaches the sea; and thus the most valuable part of our continents, the rich deltas and great alluvial plains, are prevented from being constantly under water.

The addition of a smaller river increases the speed of the main stream, often in the same proportion as it does the amount of water. So, the Venetian branch of the Po absorbed the Ferranese branch and the Panaro branch without any increase in its own size. The reason for the increased speed is that, after two rivers merge, the water has to overcome the friction of only two banks instead of four; also, because the main part of the stream is farther from the banks, it flows more smoothly; and finally, because a greater volume of water moving faster erodes deeper into the riverbed. With this smart balance, the water draining from the inland areas takes up less space as it gets closer to the sea, preventing the most productive parts of our continents—the rich deltas and large alluvial plains—from being constantly submerged.

River floods in Scotland, 1829.—Many remarkable illustrations of the power of running water in moving stones and heavy materials were afforded by the storm and floods which occurred on the 3d and 4th of August, 1829, in Aberdeenshire and other counties in Scotland. The elements during this storm assumed all the characters which mark the tropical hurricanes; the wind blowing in sudden gusts and whirlwinds, the lightning and thunder being such as is rarely witnessed in our climate, and heavy rain falling without intermission. The floods extended almost simultaneously, and with equal violence over that part 208 of the northeast of Scotland which would be cut off by two lines drawn from the head of Lochrannoch, one towards Inverness and the other to Stonehaven. The united line of the different rivers which were flooded, could not be less than from five to six hundred miles in length; and the whole of their courses were marked by the destruction of bridges, roads, crops, and buildings. Sir T. D. Lauder has recorded the destruction of thirty-eight bridges, and the entire obliteration of a great number of farms and hamlets. On the Nairn, a fragment of sandstone, fourteen feet long by three feet wide and one foot thick, was carried above 200 yards down the river. Some new ravines were formed on the sides of mountains where no streams had previously flowed, and ancient river-channels, which had never been filled from time immemorial, gave passage to a copious flood.270

River floods in Scotland, 1829.—Many striking examples of the power of moving water to transport stones and heavy materials were witnessed during the storm and floods that occurred on August 3rd and 4th, 1829, in Aberdeenshire and other counties in Scotland. The conditions during this storm mirrored those seen in tropical hurricanes; the wind blew in sudden gusts and whirlwinds, the lightning and thunder were unlike anything usually seen in our climate, and heavy rain fell continuously. The floods spread almost at the same time, and with equal intensity, over the region in the northeast of Scotland that would be bordered by two lines drawn from the head of Lochrannoch, one toward Inverness and the other to Stonehaven. The combined length of the various rivers that flooded was no less than five to six hundred miles; and the entire course of these rivers was marked by the destruction of bridges, roads, crops, and buildings. Sir T. D. Lauder reported the destruction of thirty-eight bridges and the complete devastation of numerous farms and villages. On the Nairn, a piece of sandstone measuring fourteen feet long by three feet wide and one foot thick was moved over 200 yards down the river. New ravines formed on mountain slopes where no streams had ever flowed before, and ancient riverbeds, which had not been filled for ages, became channels for a significant flood.270

The bridge over the Dee at Ballater consisted of five arches, having upon the whole a water-way of 260 feet. The bed of the river, on which the piers rested, was composed of rolled pieces of granite and gneiss. The bridge was built of granite, and had stood uninjured for twenty years; but the different parts were swept away in succession by the flood, and the whole mass of masonry disappeared in the bed of the river. "The river Don," observes Mr. Farquharson, in his account of the inundations, "has upon my own premises forced a mass of four or five hundred tons of stones, many of them two or three hundred pounds' weight, up an inclined plane, rising six feet in eight or ten yards, and left them in a rectangular heap, about three feet deep on a flat ground:—the heap ends abruptly at its lower extremity."271

The bridge over the Dee at Ballater had five arches and a total span of 260 feet. The riverbed, where the piers were anchored, was made up of rounded pieces of granite and gneiss. The bridge was constructed from granite and had remained intact for twenty years; however, various sections were gradually carried away by the flood, and the entire structure ended up submerged in the riverbed. "The river Don," notes Mr. Farquharson in his account of the floods, "has on my own property moved a mass of four or five hundred tons of stones, many weighing two or three hundred pounds, up an incline, rising six feet over eight or ten yards, and left them in a rectangular pile about three feet deep on flat ground:—the pile ends suddenly at its lower edge."271

The power even of a small rivulet, when swollen by rain, in removing heavy bodies, was exemplified in August, 1827, in the College, a small stream which flows at a slight declivity from the eastern watershed of the Cheviot Hills. Several thousand tons' weight of gravel and sand were transported to the plain of the Till, and a bridge, then in progress of building, was carried away, some of the arch-stones of which, weighing from half to three quarters of a ton each, were propelled two miles down the rivulet. On the same occasion, the current tore away from the abutment of a mill-dam a large block of greenstone-porphyry, weighing nearly two tons, and transported it to the distance of a quarter of a mile. Instances are related as occurring repeatedly, in which from one to three thousand tons of gravel are, in like manner, removed by this streamlet to still greater distances in one day.272

The strength of even a small stream, when swollen by rain, in moving heavy objects was demonstrated in August 1827, in the College, a small stream that flows slightly downhill from the eastern side of the Cheviot Hills. Several thousand tons of gravel and sand were carried to the plain of the Till, and a bridge that was under construction was washed away, with some of its arch stones, weighing between half and three-quarters of a ton each, being pushed two miles down the stream. During the same event, the current removed a large block of greenstone-porphyry weighing nearly two tons from the abutment of a mill-dam and transported it a quarter of a mile away. There have been multiple reports of instances where this stream has removed from one to three thousand tons of gravel in a single day, taking it even greater distances.272

Floods caused by landslips, 1826.—The power which running water may exert in the lapse of ages, in widening and deepening a valley, does not so much depend on the volume and velocity of the stream usually flowing in it, as on the number and magnitude of the obstructions which have, at different periods, opposed its free passage. If a torrent, however small, be effectually dammed up, the size of the valley 209 above the barrier, and its declivity below, and not the dimensions of the torrent, will determine the violence of the débâcle. The most universal source of local deluges, are landslips, slides, or avalanches, as they are sometimes called, when great masses of rock and soil, or sometimes ice and snow, are precipitated into the bed of a river, the boundary cliffs of which have been thrown down by the shock of an earthquake, or undermined by springs or other causes. Volumes might be filled with the enumeration of instances on record of these terrific catastrophes; I shall therefore select a few examples of recent occurrence, the facts of which are well authenticated.

Floods caused by landslips, 1826.—The power that flowing water can have over centuries in widening and deepening a valley doesn’t depend as much on the amount and speed of the water normally flowing through it, but rather on the number and size of the barriers that have at various times blocked its free flow. If even a small stream is effectively blocked, the size of the valley above the dam and its slope below, rather than the size of the stream, will dictate how violent the flood will be. The most common cause of local floods is landslips, slides, or avalanches—terms used when large amounts of rock and soil, or sometimes ice and snow, fall into a riverbed after the surrounding cliffs have collapsed due to an earthquake or have been eroded by springs or other factors. There are countless documented cases of these catastrophic events; therefore, I will choose a few examples from recent occurrences that are well-documented.

Two dry seasons in the White Mountains, in New Hampshire (United States), were followed by heavy rains on the 28th August, 1826, when from the steep and lofty declivities which rise abruptly on both sides of the river Saco, innumerable rocks and stones, many of sufficient size to fill a common apartment, were detached, and in their descent swept down before them, in one promiscuous and frightful ruin, forests, shrubs, and the earth which sustained them. Although there are numerous indications on the steep sides of these hills of former slides of the same kind, yet no tradition had been handed down of any similar catastrophe within the memory of man, and the growth of the forest on the very spots now devastated, clearly showed that for a long interval nothing similar had occurred. One of these moving masses was afterwards found to have slid three miles, with an average breadth of a quarter of a mile. The natural excavations commenced generally in a trench a few yards in depth and a few rods in width, and descended the mountains, widening and deepening till they became vast chasms. At the base of these hollow ravines was seen a confused mass of ruins, consisting of transported earth, gravel, rocks, and trees. Forests of spruce-fir and hemlock, a kind of fir somewhat resembling our yew in foliage, were prostrated with as much ease as if they had been fields of grain; for, where they disputed the ground, the torrent of mud and rock accumulated behind, till it gathered sufficient force to burst the temporary barrier.

Two dry seasons in the White Mountains of New Hampshire were followed by heavy rains on August 28, 1826. From the steep and high slopes on both sides of the Saco River, countless rocks and stones—many large enough to fill an average room—were dislodged. As they fell, they took down forests, shrubs, and the soil that supported them in a chaotic, terrifying collapse. Although there are many signs on the steep sides of these hills of past landslides, no stories had been passed down about a similar disaster within living memory. The growth of the forest on the very spots now devastated clearly indicated that nothing like this had happened for a long time. One of these moving masses was later found to have traveled three miles, averaging a width of a quarter of a mile. The natural excavations typically began as a trench a few yards deep and a few rods wide, then the slides descended the mountains, broadening and deepening until they formed huge chasms. At the bottom of these hollow ravines lay a chaotic pile of debris, consisting of displaced earth, gravel, rocks, and trees. Forests of spruce-fir and hemlock, a type of fir that somewhat resembles our yew in foliage, were flattened as easily as if they were fields of grain. Where they held their ground, the torrent of mud and rock built up behind them until it gained enough force to break through the temporary barrier.

The valleys of the Amonoosuck and Saco presented, for many miles, an uninterrupted scene of desolation; all the bridges being carried away, as well as those over their tributary streams. In some places, the road was excavated to the depth of from fifteen to twenty feet; in others, it was covered with earth, rocks, and trees, to as great a height. The water flowed for many weeks after the flood, as densely charged with earth as it could be without being changed into mud, and marks were seen in various localities of its having risen on either side of the valley to more than twenty-five feet above its ordinary level. Many sheep and cattle were swept away, and the Willey family, nine in number, who in alarm had deserted their house, were destroyed on the banks of the Saco; seven of their mangled bodies were afterwards found near the river, buried beneath drift-wood and mountain ruins.273 Eleven years 210 after the event, the deep channels worn by the avalanches of mud and stone, and the immense heaps of boulders and blocks of granite in the river channel, still formed, says Professor Hubbard, a picturesque feature in the scenery.274

The valleys of the Amonoosuck and Saco showed, for many miles, a continuous view of destruction; all the bridges were washed away, including those over their smaller streams. In some areas, the road was dug out to depths of fifteen to twenty feet; in other places, it was buried under earth, rocks, and trees to similar heights. The water flowed for weeks after the flood, thick with sediment but not completely muddy, and signs were visible in various locations where it had risen on both sides of the valley to over twenty-five feet above its usual level. Many sheep and cattle were lost, and the Willey family, numbering nine, who had fled their home in fear, were killed on the banks of the Saco; seven of their mangled bodies were later found near the river, covered by debris and mountain rubble.273 Eleven years 210 after the event, the deep channels created by the avalanches of mud and stone, along with the massive piles of boulders and granite blocks in the river, still made, according to Professor Hubbard, a striking part of the landscape.274

When I visited the country in 1845, eight years after Professor Hubbard, I found the signs of devastation still very striking; I also particularly remarked that although the surface of the bare granitic rocks had been smoothed by the passage over them of so much mud and stone, there were no continuous parallel and rectilinear furrows, nor any of the fine scratches or striæ which characterize glacial action. The absence of these is nowhere more clearly exemplified than in the bare rocks over which passed the great "Willey slide" of 1826.275

When I visited the country in 1845, eight years after Professor Hubbard, I found the devastation still very striking. I also noticed that even though the surface of the bare granite rocks had been smoothed by so much mud and stone passing over them, there were no continuous parallel and straight furrows, nor any of the fine scratches or striations that are typical of glacial action. The absence of these is most clearly seen in the bare rocks that were impacted by the great "Willey slide" of 1826.275

But the catastrophes in the White Mountains are insignificant, when compared to those which are occasioned by earthquakes, when the boundary hills, for miles in length, are thrown down into the hollow of a valley. I shall have opportunities of alluding to inundations of this kind, when treating expressly of earthquakes, and shall content myself at present with selecting an example of a flood due to a different cause.

But the disasters in the White Mountains are minor compared to those caused by earthquakes, where the surrounding hills are collapsed into the depths of a valley. I will have chances to refer to floods like this when specifically discussing earthquakes, and for now, I'll be satisfied with choosing an example of a flood caused by a different reason.

Flood in the valley of Bagnes, 1818.—The valley of Bagnes is one of the largest of the lateral embranchments of the main valley of the Rhone, above the Lake of Geneva. Its upper portion was, in 1818, converted into a lake by the damming up of a narrow pass, by avalanches of snow and ice, precipitated from an elevated glacier into the bed of the river Dranse. In the winter season, during continued frost, scarcely any water flows in the bed of this river to preserve an open channel, so that the ice barrier remained entire until the melting of the snows in spring, when a lake was formed above, about half a league in length, which finally attained in some parts a depth of about two hundred feet, and a width of about seven hundred feet. To prevent or lessen the mischief apprehended from the sudden bursting of the barrier, an artificial gallery, seven hundred feet in length, was cut through the ice, before the waters had risen to a great height. When at length they accumulated and flowed through this tunnel, they dissolved the ice, and thus deepened their channel, until nearly half of the whole contents of the lake were slowly drained off. But at length, on the approach of the hot season, the central portion of the remaining mass of ice gave way with a tremendous crash, and the residue of the lake was emptied in half an hour. In the course of its descent, the waters encountered several narrow gorges, and at each of these they rose to a great height, and then burst with new violence into the next basin, sweeping along rocks, forests, houses, bridges, and cultivated land. For the greater part of its course the flood resembled a moving mass of rock and mud, rather than of water. Some fragments of granitic rocks, of enormous magnitude, and which from their dimensions, might be compared without exaggeration 211 to houses, were torn out of a more ancient alluvion, and borne down for a quarter of a mile. One of the fragments moved was sixty paces in circumference.276 The velocity of the water, in the first part of its course, was thirty-three feet per second, which diminished to six feet before it reached the Lake of Geneva, where it arrived in six hours and a half, the distance being forty-five miles.277

Flood in the valley of Bagnes, 1818.—The valley of Bagnes is one of the largest side branches of the main valley of the Rhone, located above Lake Geneva. In 1818, its upper section was turned into a lake because a narrow pass was blocked by avalanches of snow and ice that crashed down from a high glacier into the riverbed of the Dranse. During winter, when it was consistently freezing, hardly any water flowed in this riverbed to keep an open channel, so the ice barrier remained intact until the snow melted in spring. This created a lake above that was about half a league long and, in some areas, reached a depth of about two hundred feet and a width of about seven hundred feet. To prevent or reduce the damage expected from the sudden breaking of this barrier, an artificial tunnel, seven hundred feet long, was carved through the ice before the water levels rose too high. Eventually, when the water accumulated and flowed through this tunnel, it melted the ice and deepened its channel, slowly draining nearly half of the lake's total volume. However, as the hot season approached, the central part of the remaining ice collapsed with a huge crash, emptying the rest of the lake in half an hour. As the water rushed down, it encountered several narrow gorges, where it rose significantly and then violently burst into the next basin, carrying away rocks, trees, buildings, bridges, and farmland. For most of its descent, the flood appeared more like a shifting mass of rock and mud than water. Some massive pieces of granite, so large they could easily be compared to houses, were pulled from older deposits and taken downstream for a quarter of a mile. One of these pieces measured sixty paces around.276 The speed of the water at the beginning of its journey was thirty-three feet per second, which slowed to six feet before it reached Lake Geneva, arriving there in six and a half hours over a distance of forty-five miles.277

This flood left behind it, on the plains of Martigny, thousands of trees torn up by the roots, together with the ruins of buildings. Some of the houses in that town were filled with mud up to the second story. After expanding in the plain of Martigny, it entered the Rhone, and did no farther damage; but some bodies of men, who had been drowned above Martigny, were afterwards found, at the distance of about thirty miles, floating on the farther side of the Lake of Geneva, near Vevay.

This flood left behind thousands of uprooted trees on the plains of Martigny, along with the ruins of buildings. Some of the houses in that town were filled with mud up to the second floor. After spreading out across the plain of Martigny, it flowed into the Rhone and did no further damage; however, some bodies of people who had drowned upstream from Martigny were later found about thirty miles away, floating on the opposite side of Lake Geneva, near Vevay.

The waters, on escaping from the temporary lake, intermixed with mud and rock, swept along, for the first four miles, at the rate of above twenty miles an hour; and M. Escher, the engineer, calculated that the flood furnished 300,000 cubic feet of water every second—an efflux which is five times greater than that of the Rhine below Basle. Now, if part of the lake had not been gradually drained off, the flood would have been nearly double, approaching in volume to some of the largest rivers in Europe. It is evident, therefore, that when we are speculating on the excavating force which a river may have exerted in any particular valley, the most important question is, not the volume of the existing stream, nor the present levels of its channel, nor even the nature of the rocks, but the probability of a succession of floods at some period since the time when the valley may have been first elevated above the sea.

The water, as it flowed out of the temporary lake, mixed with mud and rocks and rushed forward, at over twenty miles an hour for the first four miles. Engineer M. Escher calculated that the flood sent out 300,000 cubic feet of water every second—five times more than the Rhine below Basel. If some of the lake hadn’t been gradually drained, the flood would have been nearly double that, matching the volume of some of Europe’s largest rivers. So, when considering how much a river might have eroded a valley, the key question isn’t about the current water volume, the present levels of the riverbed, or the type of rocks, but rather the likelihood of a series of floods occurring at some time since the valley was first lifted above sea level.

For several months after the débâcle of 1818, the Dranse, having no settled channel, shifted its position continually from one side to the other of the valley, carrying away newly-erected bridges, undermining houses, and continuing to be charged with as large a quantity of earthy matter as the fluid could hold in suspension. I visited this valley four months after the flood, and was witness to the sweeping away of a bridge, and the undermining of part of a house. The greater part of the ice-barrier was then standing, presenting vertical cliffs 150 feet high, like ravines in the lava-currents of Etna or Auvergne, where they are intersected by rivers.

For several months after the disaster of 1818, the Dranse, lacking a fixed channel, constantly shifted from one side of the valley to the other, washing away newly constructed bridges, undermining houses, and carrying a large amount of sediment in suspension. I visited this valley four months after the flood and witnessed the destruction of a bridge and the undermining of part of a house. Most of the ice-barrier was still standing, forming vertical cliffs 150 feet high, resembling ravines in the lava flows of Etna or Auvergne, where they intersect with rivers.

Inundations, precisely similar, are recorded to have occurred at former periods in this district, and from the same cause. In 1595, for example, a lake burst, and the waters, descending with irresistible fury, destroyed the town of Martigny, where from sixty to eighty persons perished. In a similar flood, fifty years before, 140 persons were drowned.

Inundations that were exactly the same have been recorded in this area during earlier times, caused by the same reason. For instance, in 1595, a lake overflowed, and the waters rushed down with unstoppable force, destroying the town of Martigny, where about sixty to eighty people lost their lives. In a comparable flood fifty years earlier, 140 people drowned.

Flood at Tivoli, 1826.—I shall conclude with one more example derived from a land of classic recollections, the ancient Tibur, and which, 212 like all the other inundations above alluded to, occurred within the present century. The younger Pliny, it will be remembered, describes a flood on the Anio, which destroyed woods, rocks, and houses, with the most sumptuous villas and works of arts.278 For four or five centuries consecutively, this "headlong stream," as Horace truly called it, has often remained within its bounds, and then, after so long an interval of rest, has at different periods inundated its banks again, and widened its channel. The last of these catastrophes happened 15th Nov. 1826, after heavy rains, such as produced the floods before alluded to in Scotland. The waters appear also to have been impeded by an artificial dike, by which they were separated into two parts, a short distance above Tivoli. They broke through this dike; and leaving the left trench dry, precipitated themselves, with their whole weight, on the right side. Here they undermined, in the course of a few hours, a high cliff, and widened the river's channel about fifteen paces. On this height stood the church of St. Lucia, and about thirty-six houses of the town of Tivoli, which were all carried away, presenting as they sank into the roaring flood, a terrific scene of destruction to the spectators on the opposite bank. As the foundations were gradually removed, each building, some of them edifices of considerable height, was first traversed with numerous rents, which soon widened into large fissures, until at length the roofs fell in with a crash, and then the walls sunk into the river, and were hurled down the cataract below.279

Flood at Tivoli, 1826.—I’ll wrap up with one more example from a place filled with historical memories, the ancient Tibur, which, like all the other floods mentioned earlier, happened in this century. The younger Pliny famously describes a flood on the Anio that destroyed forests, rocks, and homes, including luxurious villas and works of art.278 For four or five consecutive centuries, this "rushing stream," as Horace aptly called it, often stayed within its banks but then, after long periods of calm, flooded its banks again and widened its channel at various times. The last of these disasters occurred on November 15, 1826, after heavy rains similar to those that caused the floods mentioned earlier in Scotland. The waters also seemed to be blocked by an artificial dike that separated them into two parts just above Tivoli. They broke through this dike, leaving the left channel dry, and poured their full force into the right side. Here, they quickly eroded a high cliff and widened the river’s channel by about fifteen paces. On this height stood the church of St. Lucia and around thirty-six houses in the town of Tivoli, all of which were swept away, creating a terrifying scene of destruction for those watching from the opposite bank. As the foundations were slowly washed away, each building, some of significant height, first developed numerous cracks that quickly turned into large fissures. Eventually, the roofs collapsed with a crash, and the walls sank into the river, tumbling down the waterfall below.279

The destroying agency of the flood came within two hundred yards of the precipice on which the beautiful temple of Vesta stands; but fortunately this precious relic of antiquity was spared, while the wreck of modern structures was hurled down the abyss. Vesta, it will be remembered, in the heathen mythology, personified the stability of the earth; and when the Samian astronomer, Aristarchus, first taught that the earth revolved on its axis, and round the sun, he was publicly accused of impiety, "for removing the everlasting Vesta from her place." Playfair observed, that when Hutton ascribed instability to the earth's surface, and represented the continents which we inhabit as the theatre of incessant change and movement, his antagonists, who regarded them as unalterable, assailed him in a similar manner with accusations founded on religious prejudices.280 We might appeal to the excavating power of the Anio as corroborative of one of the most controverted parts of the Huttonian theory; and if the days of omens had not gone by, the geologists who now worship Vesta might regard the late catastrophe as portentous. We may, at least, recommend the modern votaries of the goddess to lose no time in making a pilgrimage to her shrine, for the next flood may not respect the temple.

The destructive force of the flood came within two hundred yards of the cliff where the beautiful temple of Vesta stands; but luckily, this valuable relic of the past was spared, while the ruins of modern buildings were thrown into the abyss. Vesta, as you may recall from ancient mythology, represented the stability of the earth; and when the Samian astronomer, Aristarchus, first suggested that the earth rotates on its axis and revolves around the sun, he was publicly accused of impiety "for moving the everlasting Vesta from her place." Playfair noted that when Hutton claimed the earth's surface was unstable and portrayed the continents we live on as constantly changing and moving, his opponents, who believed they were unchangeable, attacked him in a similar way with accusations based on religious biases.280 We could point to the eroding power of the Anio as evidence for one of the most debated parts of Hutton's theory; and if the days of omens weren’t behind us, the geologists who now worship Vesta might see the recent disaster as a sign. At the very least, we should encourage today's followers of the goddess to make a pilgrimage to her shrine quickly, because the next flood might not spare the temple.

Excavation of rocks by running water.—The rapidity with which 213 even the smallest streams hollow out deep channels in soft and destructible soils is remarkably exemplified in volcanic countries, where the sand and half-consolidated tuffs opposed but a slight resistance to the torrents which descend the mountain-side. After the heavy rains which followed the eruption of Vesuvius in 1824, the water flowing from the Atrio del Cavallo cut, in three days, a new chasm through strata of tuff and ejected volcanic matter, to the depth of twenty-five feet. I found the old mule-road, in 1828, intersected by this new ravine.

Excavation of rocks by running water.—The speed at which 213 even the smallest streams carve out deep channels in soft and fragile soils is clearly shown in volcanic areas, where the sand and partially solidified tuffs offer only minimal resistance to the torrents flowing down the mountainside. After the heavy rains that followed the eruption of Vesuvius in 1824, the water from the Atrio del Cavallo created a new chasm through layers of tuff and ejected volcanic material, reaching a depth of twenty-five feet in just three days. I found that the old mule-road, in 1828, was cut through by this new ravine.

The gradual erosion of deep chasms through some of the hardest rocks, by the constant passage of running water, charged with foreign matter, is another phenomenon of which striking examples may be adduced. Illustrations of this excavating power are presented by many valleys in central France where the channels of rivers have been barred up by solid currents of lava, through which the streams have re-excavated a passage, to the depth of from twenty to seventy feet and upwards, and often of great width. In these cases there are decisive proofs that neither the sea, nor any denuding wave or extraordinary body of water, has passed over the spot since the melted lava was consolidated. Every hypothesis of the intervention of sudden and violent agency is entirely excluded, because the cones of loose scoriæ, out of which the lavas flowed, are oftentimes at no great elevation above the rivers, and have remained undisturbed during the whole period which has been sufficient for the hollowing out of such enormous ravines.

The gradual erosion of deep gorges through some of the toughest rocks, caused by the continuous flow of water carrying debris, is another remarkable phenomenon with striking examples. Many valleys in central France illustrate this powerful erosion, where rivers have carved out channels through solid lava flows, reaching depths of twenty to seventy feet or more, often quite wide. In these instances, there is clear evidence that neither the sea nor any erosive wave or extraordinary body of water has covered the area since the lava solidified. Any theory suggesting a sudden and violent event can be completely ruled out, as the cones of loose scoria, from which the lava flowed, are frequently not much higher than the rivers and have remained undisturbed throughout the entire period that has allowed for the creation of such massive ravines.

Recent excavation by the Simeto.—But I shall at present confine myself to examples derived from events which have happened since the time of history.

Recent excavation by the Simeto.—For now, I will focus on examples from events that have occurred since the beginning of recorded history.

Fig. 16.

Fig. 16.

Recent excavation of lava.

Recent excavation of lava at the foot of Etna by the river Simeto.

Recent excavation of lava at the base of Etna by the Simeto River.

At the western base of Etna, a current of lava (A A, fig. 16), descending from near the summit of the great volcano, has flowed to the distance of five or six miles, and then reached the alluvial plain of the Simeto, the largest of the Sicilian rivers, which skirts the base of Etna, and falls into the sea a few miles south of Catania. The lava entered the river about three miles above the town of Aderno, and not only occupied its channel for some distance, but, crossing to the opposite side of the valley, accumulated there in a rocky mass. Gemmellaro gives the year 1603 as the date of the eruption.281 The appearance of the 214 current clearly proves, that it is one of the most modern of those of Etna; for it has not been covered or crossed by subsequent streams or ejections, and the olives which had been planted on its surface were all of small size, when I examined the spot in 1828, yet they were older than the natural wood on the same lava. In the course, therefore, of about two centuries, the Simeto has eroded a passage from fifty to several hundred feet wide, and in some parts from forty to fifty feet deep.

At the western base of Etna, a flow of lava (A A, fig. 16) coming down from near the top of the great volcano has traveled about five or six miles and reached the alluvial plain of the Simeto, the largest river in Sicily, which runs alongside Etna and flows into the sea a few miles south of Catania. The lava entered the river around three miles upstream from the town of Aderno, occupying its channel for a distance and, crossing to the other side of the valley, built up a rocky mass there. Gemmellaro dates the eruption to 1603.281 The appearance of the214 flow clearly indicates that it is one of the most recent from Etna; it hasn't been covered or crossed by later flows or eruptions, and the olive trees that had been planted on it were all small when I checked the site in 1828, even though they were older than the natural forest growing on the same lava. Over the course of about two centuries, the Simeto has carved out a passage ranging from fifty to several hundred feet wide and in some areas from forty to fifty feet deep.

The portion of lava cut through is in no part porous or scoriaceous, but consists of a compact homogeneous mass of hard blue rock, somewhat inferior in weight to ordinary basalt, and containing crystals of olivine and glassy felspar. The general declivity of this part of the bed of the Simeto is not considerable; but, in consequence of the unequal waste of the lava, two water-falls occur at Passo Manzanelli, each about six feet in height. Here the chasm (B, fig. 16) is about forty feet deep, and only fifty broad.

The section of lava we've examined is completely solid and non-porous, made up of a dense, uniform mass of hard blue rock that’s a bit lighter than regular basalt, containing crystals of olivine and glassy feldspar. The overall slope in this area of the Simeto riverbed isn’t steep, but due to the uneven erosion of the lava, there are two waterfalls at Passo Manzanelli, each around six feet tall. Here, the gorge (B, fig. 16) is about forty feet deep and only fifty feet wide.

The sand and pebbles in the river-bed consist chiefly of a brown quartzose sandstone, derived from the upper country; but the materials of the volcanic rock itself must have greatly assisted the attrition. This river, like the Caltabiano on the eastern side of Etna, has not yet cut down to the ancient bed of which it was dispossessed, and of which the probable position is indicated in the annexed diagram (C, fig. 16).

The sand and pebbles in the riverbed mainly consist of a brown quartz sandstone coming from the higher areas; however, the materials from the volcanic rock itself must have significantly contributed to the erosion. This river, similar to the Caltabiano on the eastern side of Etna, has not yet eroded down to the ancient bed it replaced, and its likely location is shown in the attached diagram (C, fig. 16).

On entering the narrow ravine where the water foams down the two cataracts, we are entirely shut out from all view of the surrounding country; and a geologist who is accustomed to associate the characteristic features of the landscape with the relative age of certain rocks, can scarcely dissuade himself from the belief that he is contemplating a scene in some rocky gorge of a primary district. The external forms of the hard blue lava are as massive as any of the most ancient trap-rocks of Scotland. The solid surface is in some parts smoothed and almost polished by attrition, and covered in others with a white lichen, which imparts to it an air of extreme antiquity, so as greatly to heighten the delusion. But the moment we reascend the cliff the spell is broken; for we scarcely recede a few paces, before the ravine and river disappear, and we stand on the black and rugged surface of a vast current of lava, which seems unbroken, and which we can trace up nearly to the distant summit of that majestic cone which Pindar called "the pillar of heaven," and which still continues to send forth a fleecy wreath of vapor, reminding us that its fires are not extinct, and that it may again give out a rocky stream, wherein other scenes like that now described may present themselves to future observers.

Upon entering the narrow ravine where the water rushes down the two waterfalls, we are completely cut off from all views of the surrounding area. A geologist, used to linking the distinct features of the landscape with the relative age of certain rocks, can hardly convince himself that he isn’t looking at a scene from some rocky gorge in a primitive region. The shapes of the hard blue lava are as solid as the most ancient trap rocks of Scotland. In some spots, the surface is smoothed and almost polished from wear, while in others, it’s covered with a white lichen that gives it an impression of extreme age, enhancing the illusion. But the moment we climb back up the cliff, the magic fades; we barely take a few steps back before the ravine and river vanish, and we find ourselves on the black, rugged surface of a vast lava flow that appears uninterrupted, which we can trace all the way up to the distant peak of that majestic cone, which Pindar referred to as "the pillar of heaven," still sending up a fluffy plume of vapor, reminding us that its fires aren’t out, and it could again erupt, creating another rocky stream where similar landscapes might eventually be seen by future observers.

Fig. 17. Lake Erie. The Falls.  
Lake Erie. The Falls.
Limestone Shale.
Lewiston. Niagara River. Queenstown.  

Falls of Niagara.—The falls of Niagara afford a magnificent example of the progressive excavation of a deep valley in solid rock. That river flows over a flat table-land, in a depression of which Lake Erie is situated. Where it issues from the lake, it is nearly a mile in width, and 330 feet above Lake Ontario, which is about 30 miles distant. For the first fifteen miles below Lake Erie the surrounding country, comprising Upper Canada on the west, and the state of New York on the 216 east, is almost on a level with its banks, and nowhere more than thirty or forty feet above them.282 (See fig. 17.) The river being occasionally interspersed with low wooded islands, and having sometimes a width of three miles, glides along at first with a clear, smooth, and tranquil current, falling only fifteen feet in as many miles, and in this part of its course resembling an arm of Lake Erie. But its character is afterwards entirely changed, on approaching the Rapids, where it begins to rush and foam over a rocky and uneven limestone bottom, for the space of nearly a mile, till at length it is thrown down perpendicularly 165 feet at the Falls. Here the river is divided into two sheets of water by an island, the largest cataract being more than a third of a mile broad, the smaller one having a breadth of six hundred feet. When the water has precipitated itself into an unfathomable pool, it rushes with great velocity down the sloping bottom of a narrow chasm, for a distance of seven miles. This ravine varies from 200 to 400 yards in width from cliff to cliff; contrasting, therefore, strongly in its breadth with that of the river above. Its depth is from 200 to 300 feet, and it intersects for about seven miles the table-land before described, which terminates suddenly at Queenstown in an escarpment or long line of inland cliff facing northwards, towards Lake Ontario. The Niagara, on reaching the escarpment and issuing from the gorge, enters the flat country, which is so nearly on a level with Lake Ontario, that there is only a fall of about four feet in the seven additional miles which intervene between Queenstown and the shores of that lake.

Niagara Falls.—Niagara Falls provides a stunning example of how a deep valley in solid rock is gradually formed. The river flows over a flat plateau where Lake Erie is located. At the point it exits the lake, it spans nearly a mile in width and is 330 feet higher than Lake Ontario, which is about 30 miles away. For the first fifteen miles below Lake Erie, the surrounding land, including Upper Canada to the west and New York to the east, is almost at the same level as the riverbanks, rising no more than thirty or forty feet above them.282 (See fig. 17.) The river, dotted with low wooded islands and sometimes expanding to three miles wide, initially flows with a clear, smooth, and calm current, dropping only fifteen feet over that distance, resembling an extension of Lake Erie. However, its nature completely changes as it approaches the Rapids, where it starts to surge and foam over a rocky, uneven limestone bed for nearly a mile before plunging vertically 165 feet at the Falls. Here, the river splits into two torrents by an island, with the larger waterfall stretching over a third of a mile wide and the smaller one measuring six hundred feet across. After falling into a deep pool, the water rushes rapidly down the sloped floor of a narrow gorge for seven miles. This canyon varies from 200 to 400 yards wide from one cliff to another, creating a sharp contrast in width compared to the river above. The depth is between 200 and 300 feet, cutting through the aforementioned plateau, which ends abruptly at Queenstown with a steep cliff facing north toward Lake Ontario. When the Niagara reaches this cliff and exits the gorge, it enters flat land that is almost level with Lake Ontario, resulting in only a drop of about four feet over the seven miles that separate Queenstown from the lake's shoreline.

It has long been the popular belief that the Niagara once flowed in a shallow valley across the whole platform, from the present site of the Falls to the escarpment (called the Queenstown heights), where it is supposed that the cataract was first situated, and that the river has been slowly eating its way backwards through the rocks for the distance of seven miles. This hypothesis naturally suggests itself to every observer, who sees the narrowness of the gorge at its termination, and throughout its whole course, as far up as the Falls, above which point the river expands as before stated. The boundary cliffs of the ravine are usually perpendicular, and in many places undermined on one side by the impetuous stream. The uppermost rock of the table-land at the Falls consists of hard limestone (a member of the Silurian series), about ninety feet thick, beneath which lie soft shales of equal thickness, continually undermined by the action of the spray, which rises from the pool into which so large a body of water is projected, and is driven violently by gusts of wind against the base of the 217 precipice. In consequence of this action, and that of frost, the shale disintegrates and crumbles away, and portions of the incumbent rock overhang 40 feet, and often when unsupported tumble down, so that the Falls do not remain absolutely stationary at the same spot, even for half a century. Accounts have come down to us, from the earliest period of observation, of the frequent destruction of these rocks, and the sudden descent of huge fragments in 1818 and 1828, are said to have shaken the adjacent country like an earthquake. The earliest travellers, Hennepin and Kalm, who in 1678 and 1751 visited the Falls, and published views of them, attest the fact, that the rocks have been suffering from dilapidation for more than a century and a half, and that some slight changes, even in the scenery of the cataract have been brought about within that time. The idea, therefore, of perpetual and progressive waste is constantly present to the mind of every beholder; and as that part of the chasm, which has been the work of the last hundred and fifty years resembles precisely, in depth, width, and character, the rest of the gorge which extends seven miles below, it is most natural to infer, that the entire ravine has been hollowed out in the same manner, by the recession of the cataract.

It has long been a common belief that Niagara once flowed through a shallow valley that stretched across the entire area, from the current site of the Falls to the escarpment (known as the Queenstown heights), where it is thought the waterfall was originally located. The river has supposedly been gradually carving its way backward through the rock for seven miles. This idea naturally comes to mind for anyone observing the narrowness of the gorge at its end and throughout its entire course, up to the Falls, above which the river widens as mentioned earlier. The cliff edges of the ravine are usually vertical, and in many areas, one side is undermined by the rushing water. The topmost rock at the Falls is hard limestone (part of the Silurian series), about ninety feet thick, beneath which lie soft shales of the same thickness, continually eroded by the spray that rises from the large volume of water crashing into the pool, driven forcefully by gusts of wind against the base of the 217 cliff. Because of this action, along with the effects of frost, the shale breaks down and crumbles away, causing pieces of the overlying rock to hang precariously 40 feet out, often falling when unsupported. As a result, the Falls do not stay in the same position for even half a century. Historical accounts from the earliest periods of observation note frequent rock collapses, with massive chunks falling in 1818 and 1828, shaking the surrounding area like an earthquake. The first travelers, Hennepin and Kalm, who visited the Falls in 1678 and 1751 and published their observations, confirm that the rocks have been deteriorating for over a century and a half, and that some minor changes in the scenery of the waterfall have occurred during that time. The notion of ongoing and gradual erosion is always in the mind of every observer; and since the part of the gorge created in the last hundred and fifty years closely resembles, in depth, width, and character, the remaining section that extends seven miles downstream, it is very natural to conclude that the entire ravine has been shaped in the same way by the retreat of the waterfall.

It must at least be conceded, that the river supplies an adequate cause for executing the whole task thus assigned to it, provided we grant sufficient time for its completion. As this part of the country was a wilderness till near the end of the last century, we can obtain no accurate data for estimating the exact rate at which the cataract has been receding. Mr. Bakewell, son of the eminent geologist of that name, who visited the Niagara in 1829, made the first attempt to calculate from the observations of one who had lived forty years at the Falls, and who had been the first settler there, that the cataract had during that period gone back about a yard annually. But after the most careful inquiries which I was able to make, during my visit to the spot in 1841-2, I came to the conclusion that the average of one foot a year would be a much more probable conjecture. In that case, it would have required thirty-five thousand years for the retreat of the Falls, from the escarpment of Queenstown to their present site. It seems by no means improbable that such a result would be no exaggeration of the truth, although we cannot assume that the retrograde movement has been uniform. An examination of the geological structure of the district, as laid open in the ravine, shows that at every step in the process of excavation, the height of the precipice, the hardness of the materials at its base, and the quantity of fallen matter to be removed, must have varied. At some points it may have receded much faster than at present, but in general its progress was probably slower, because the cataract, when it began to recede, must have had nearly twice its present height.

It must be acknowledged that the river provides a reasonable reason for completing the entire task assigned to it, as long as we allow enough time for it to be finished. Since this area was a wilderness until near the end of the last century, we can't get accurate data to estimate exactly how fast the waterfall has been moving back. Mr. Bakewell, the son of the well-known geologist of the same name, who visited Niagara in 1829, made the first attempt to estimate from the observations of someone who lived at the Falls for forty years and was the first settler there, that the waterfall had receded about a yard each year during that time. However, after conducting thorough inquiries during my visit to the site in 1841-42, I concluded that an average of one foot per year would be a much more likely estimate. If that’s the case, it would have taken thirty-five thousand years for the Falls to retreat from the escarpment of Queenstown to their current location. It seems quite possible that such a conclusion wouldn't be an exaggeration of the truth, even though we can't assume the rate of retreat has been consistent. An examination of the geological structure of the area, as revealed in the ravine, shows that at every stage of the excavation process, the height of the cliff, the hardness of the base materials, and the amount of fallen debris that needed to be removed would have varied. In some places, it might have receded much faster than it does now, but overall, its retreat was likely slower because the waterfall, when it first started receding, must have been nearly twice its current height.

From observations made by me in 1841, when I had the advantage of being accompanied by Mr. Hall, state geologist of New York, and in 1842, when I re-examined the Niagara district, I obtained geological218 evidence of the former existence of an old river-bed, which, I have no doubt, indicates the original channel through which the waters once flowed from the Falls to Queenstown, at the height of nearly three hundred feet above the bottom of the present gorge. The geological monuments alluded to, consist of patches of sand and gravel, forty feet thick, containing fluviatile shells of the genera Unio, Cyclas, Melania, &c., such as now inhabit the waters of the Niagara above the Falls. The identity of the fossil species with the recent is unquestionable, and these freshwater deposits occur at the edge of the cliffs bounding the ravine, so that they prove the former extension of an elevated shallow valley, four miles below the falls, a distinct prolongation of that now occupied by the Niagara, in the elevated region intervening between Lake Erie and the Falls. Whatever theory be framed for the hollowing out of the ravine further down, or for the three miles which intervene between the whirlpool and Queenstown, it will always be necessary to suppose the former existence of a barrier of rock, not of loose and destructible materials, such as those composing the drift in this district, somewhere immediately below the whirlpool. By that barrier the waters were held back for ages, when the fluviatile deposit, 40 feet in thickness, and 250 feet above the present channel of the river, originated. If we are led by this evidence to admit that the cataract has cut back its way for four miles, we can have little hesitation in referring the excavation of the remaining three miles below to a like agency, the shape of the chasm being precisely similar.

From my observations in 1841, when I was fortunate to be joined by Mr. Hall, the state geologist of New York, and again in 1842 when I looked at the Niagara area, I found geological218 evidence of an ancient riverbed that clearly shows the original path the waters took from the Falls to Queenstown, nearly three hundred feet above the bottom of the current gorge. The geological features I referenced consist of layers of sand and gravel, forty feet thick, that contain freshwater shells from species like Unio, Cyclas, Melania, etc., which still live in the waters of Niagara above the Falls. The identification of these fossil species with their modern counterparts is clear, and these freshwater deposits are located at the edge of the cliffs that border the ravine, indicating that there used to be a broad, shallow valley extending four miles below the Falls, a clear extension of what is now occupied by the Niagara River in the elevated area between Lake Erie and the Falls. No matter what theory is developed about the formation of the ravine further down or the three miles between the whirlpool and Queenstown, we must always assume that there was once a barrier of rock, not just loose and erodible materials like those found in this area's drift, located just below the whirlpool. This barrier held back the waters for ages, allowing the freshwater deposit, 40 feet thick and 250 feet above the river’s current channel, to form. If we accept this evidence, it's reasonable to conclude that the cataract has eroded its way back over four miles, and we can confidently attribute the excavation of the remaining three miles below to a similar process, as the shape of the chasm is exactly alike.

There have been many speculations respecting the future recession of the Falls, and the deluge that might be occasioned by the sudden escape of the waters of Lake Erie, if the ravine should ever be prolonged 16 miles backwards. But a more accurate knowledge of the geological succession of the rocks, brought to light by the State Survey, has satisfied every geologist that the Falls would diminish gradually in height before they travelled back two miles, and in consequence of a gentle dip of the strata to the south, the massive limestone now at the top would then be at their base, and would retard, and perhaps put an effectual stop to, the excavating process.

There has been a lot of speculation about the future recession of the Falls and the potential flood that could result from the sudden release of water from Lake Erie if the ravine were ever to extend 16 miles back. However, a better understanding of the geological layers revealed by the State Survey has convinced geologists that the Falls would gradually decrease in height before they moved back two miles. Due to a gentle dip in the layers to the south, the large limestone that is currently at the top would eventually be at the bottom, which would slow down, and possibly halt, the erosion process.


CHAPTER XV.

TRANSPORTATION OF SOLID MATTER BY ICE.

Carrying power of river-ice—Rocks annually conveyed into the St. Lawrence by its tributaries—Ground-ice; its origin and transporting power—Glaciers—Theory of their downward movement—Smoothed and grooved rocks—The moraine unstratified—Icebergs covered with mud and stones—Limits of glaciers and icebergs—Their effects on the bottom when they run aground—Packing of coast-ice—Boulders drifted by ice on coast of Labrador—Blocks moved by ice in the Baltic.

Carrying capacity of river ice—Rocks brought into the St. Lawrence every year by its tributaries—Ground ice; its source and transport ability—Glaciers—Theory of their downward motion—Smoothed and grooved rocks—The unstratified moraine—Icebergs coated with mud and stones—Boundaries of glaciers and icebergs—Their impact on the seabed when they get stuck—Packing of coastal ice—Boulders carried by ice along the coast of Labrador—Blocks shifted by ice in the Baltic.

The power of running water to carry sand, gravel, and fragments of rock to considerable distances is greatly augmented in those regions where, during some part of the year, the frost is of sufficient intensity to convert the water, either at the surface or bottom of rivers, into ice.

The ability of flowing water to transport sand, gravel, and bits of rock over long distances significantly increases in areas where, for part of the year, the frost is strong enough to turn the water, either at the surface or the bottom of rivers, into ice.

This subject may be considered under three different heads:—first, the effect of surface-ice and ground-ice in enabling streams to remove gravel and stones to a distance; secondly, the action of glaciers in the transport of boulders, and in the polishing and scratching of rocks; thirdly, the floating off of glaciers charged with solid matter into the sea, and the drifting of icebergs and coast-ice.

This topic can be looked at from three angles: first, how surface ice and ground ice help streams carry gravel and stones over distances; second, the role of glaciers in moving boulders and in polishing and scratching rocks; third, the breaking off of glaciers loaded with solid materials into the sea, along with the drifting of icebergs and coastal ice.

River-ice.—Pebbles and small pieces of rock may be seen entangled in ice, and floating annually down the Tay in Scotland, as far as the mouth of that river. Similar observations might doubtless be made respecting almost all the larger rivers of England and Scotland; but there seems reason to suspect that the principal transfer from place to place of pebbles and stones adhering to ice goes on unseen by us under water. For although the specific gravity of the compound mass may cause it to sink, it may still be very buoyant, and easily borne along by a feeble current. The ice, moreover, melts very slowly at the bottom of running streams in winter, as the water there is often nearly at the freezing point, as will be seen from what will be said in the sequel of ground-ice.

River-ice.—You can spot pebbles and small rocks stuck in the ice, drifting down the Tay River in Scotland every year, all the way to its mouth. Similar observations could likely be made about almost all the larger rivers in England and Scotland; however, it seems that the main movement of pebbles and stones attached to the ice probably happens out of sight beneath the water. Even though the overall weight of the mass might make it sink, it can still be quite buoyant and easily carried along by a weak current. Additionally, the ice melts very slowly at the bottom of flowing streams in winter since the water there is often close to freezing, as will be discussed later regarding ground-ice.

As we traverse Europe in the latitudes of Great Britain, we find the winters more severe, and the rivers more regularly frozen over. M. Lariviere relates that, being at Memel on the Baltic in 1821, when the ice of the river Niemen broke up, he saw a mass of ice thirty feet long which had descended the stream, and had been thrown ashore. In the middle of it was a triangular piece of granite, about a yard in diameter, resembling in composition the red granite of Finland.283

As we travel through Europe, especially in Great Britain, we notice the winters are harsher, and the rivers freeze over more consistently. M. Lariviere mentions that while he was in Memel on the Baltic in 1821, he saw a chunk of ice around thirty feet long that had floated down the Niemen River and gotten washed ashore after the ice broke up. In the center of this ice was a triangular piece of granite, about a yard wide, similar in composition to the red granite found in Finland.283

220 When rivers in the northern hemisphere flow from south to north, the ice first breaks up in the higher part of their course, and the flooded waters, bearing along large icy fragments, often arrive at parts of the stream which are still firmly frozen over. Great inundations are thus frequently occasioned by the obstructions thrown in the way of the descending waters, as in the case of the Mackenzie in North America, and the Irtish, Obi, Yenesei, Lena, and other rivers of Siberia. (See map, fig. 1, p. 79.) A partial stoppage of this kind lately occurred (Jan. 31, 1840) in the Vistula, about a mile and a half above the city of Dantzic, where the river, choked up by packed ice, was made to take a new course over its right bank, so that it hollowed out in a few days a deep and broad channel, many leagues in length, through a tract of sand-hills which were from 40 to 60 feet high.

220 In the northern hemisphere, when rivers flow from south to north, the ice breaks up first in the upper sections. The rushing waters, carrying large chunks of ice, often reach parts of the river that are still frozen solid. This can cause significant flooding due to the obstacles blocking the flowing water, as seen with the Mackenzie River in North America and the Irtish, Obi, Yenesei, Lena, and other Siberian rivers. (See map, fig. 1, p. 79.) A recent blockage occurred on January 31, 1840, in the Vistula River, about a mile and a half upstream from Dantzic, where the river, jammed with packed ice, was forced to carve a new path along its right bank, creating a deep and wide channel that extended for many leagues through sand hills that were 40 to 60 feet high.

In Canada, where the winter's cold is intense, in a latitude corresponding to that of central France, several tributaries of the St. Lawrence begin to thaw in their upper course, while they remain frozen over lower down, and thus large slabs of ice are set free and thrown upon the unbroken sheet of ice below. Then begins what is called the packing of the drifted fragments; that is to say, one slab is made to slide over another, until a vast pile is built up, and the whole being frozen together, is urged onwards by the force of the dammed up waters and drift-ice. Thus propelled, it not only forces along boulders, but breaks off from cliffs, which border the rivers, huge pieces of projecting rock. By this means several buttresses of solid masonry, which, up to the year 1836, supported a wooden bridge on the St. Maurice, which falls into the St. Lawrence, near the town of Trois Rivières, lat. 46° 20', were thrown down, and conveyed by the ice into the main river; and instances have occurred at Montreal of wharfs and stone-buildings, from 30 to 50 feet square, having been removed in a similar manner. We learn from Captain Bayfield that anchors laid down within high-water mark, to secure vessels hauled on shore for the winter, must be cut out of the ice on the approach of spring, or they would be carried away. In 1834, the Gulnare's bower-anchor, weighing half a ton, was transported some yards by the ice, and so firmly was it fixed, that the force of the moving ice broke a chain-cable suited for a 10-gun brig, and which had rode the Gulnare during the heaviest gales in the gulf. Had not this anchor been cut out of the ice, it would have been earned into deep water and lost.284

In Canada, where the winter cold is severe, in a region similar to central France, several tributaries of the St. Lawrence start to thaw at their upper sections while still being frozen lower down. This causes large chunks of ice to break free and slide onto the solid ice below. This process is known as the packing of the drifted fragments; one slab moves over another, creating a massive pile that eventually freezes together and is pushed forward by the pressure of the accumulated waters and drift-ice. As it moves, it not only carries boulders along but also breaks off huge chunks of rock from the cliffs lining the rivers. Because of this, several solid masonry supports, which held up a wooden bridge on the St. Maurice River—flowing into the St. Lawrence near Trois Rivières until 1836—were knocked down and carried by the ice into the main river. There have also been instances in Montreal where wharfs and stone buildings, measuring between 30 and 50 feet square, were similarly displaced. Captain Bayfield notes that anchors placed within the high-water mark to secure boats pulled ashore for the winter must be cut out of the ice when spring arrives, or they would be taken away. In 1834, the Gulnare’s bower-anchor, weighing half a ton, was moved several yards by the ice, and it was so securely embedded that the moving ice snapped a chain-cable designed for a 10-gun brig, which had held the Gulnare during the harshest storms in the gulf. If this anchor hadn’t been cut out of the ice, it would have been carried into deeper water and lost.284

PLATE II.

Plate II.



Boulders drifted by ice.

BOULDERS DRIFTED BY ICE ON SHORES OF THE ST. LAWRENCE
View taken by Lieut. Bowen, from the N. E., in the Spring of 1835, at Richelieu Rapid, lat. 46° N.

BOULDERS DRIFTED BY ICE ON SHORES OF THE ST. LAWRENCE
View taken by Lieut. Bowen, from the N. E., in the Spring of 1835, at Richelieu Rapid, lat. 46° N.

The scene represented in the annexed plate (pl. 2), from a drawing by Lieutenant Bowen, R. N., will enable the reader to comprehend the incessant changes which the transport of boulders produces annually on the low islands, shores, and bed of the St. Lawrence above Quebec. The fundamental rocks at Richelieu Rapid, situated in lat. 46° N., are limestone and slate, which are seen at low-water to be covered with boulders of granite. These boulders owe their spheroidal form chiefly to 221 weathering, or action of frost, which causes the surface to exfoliate in concentric plates, so that all the more prominent angles are removed. At the point a is a cavity in the mud or sand of the beach, now filled with water, which was occupied during the preceding winter (1835) by the huge erratic b, a mass of granite, 70 tons' weight, found in the spring following (1836) at a distance of several feet from its former position. Many small islands are seen on the river, such as c d, which afford still more striking proofs of the carrying and propelling power of ice. These islets are never under water, yet every winter ice is thrown upon them in such abundance, that it packs to the height of 20, and even 30 feet, bringing with it a continual supply of large stones or boulders, and carrying away others; the greatest number being deposited, according to Lieutenant Bowen, on the edge of deep water. On the island d, on the left of the accompanying view, a lighthouse is represented, consisting of a square wooden building, which having no other foundation than the boulders, requires to be taken down every winter, and rebuilt on the reopening of the river.

The scene shown in the attached image (pl. 2), based on a drawing by Lieutenant Bowen, R.N., helps the reader understand the constant changes caused by the movement of boulders each year on the low islands, shores, and riverbed of the St. Lawrence above Quebec. The main rocks at Richelieu Rapid, located at 46° N latitude, are limestone and slate, which, at low water, are covered with granite boulders. These boulders have a rounded shape mainly due to 221 weathering, or frost action, which makes the surface break away in concentric layers, smoothing out the sharp edges. At point a, there's a hole in the mud or sand of the beach, now filled with water, that was previously occupied during the winter of 1835 by a large erratic boulder b weighing 70 tons, which was found in the following spring (1836) several feet away from where it originally was. Many small islands, like c d, can be seen in the river, which provide even more clear evidence of the transporting and pushing power of ice. These islets are never submerged, yet every winter ice piles up on them so heavily that it can reach heights of 20 to even 30 feet, bringing large stones or boulders with it and taking others away; according to Lieutenant Bowen, the most are deposited at the edge of the deep water. On island d, to the left of the accompanying view, a lighthouse is depicted, consisting of a square wooden building that has no other foundation than the boulders, which needs to be taken down every winter and rebuilt when the river reopens.

These effects of frost, which are so striking on the St. Lawrence above Quebec, are by no means displayed on a smaller scale below that city, where the gulf rises and falls with the tide. On the contrary; it is in the estuary, between the latitudes 47° and 49°, that the greatest quantity of gravel and boulders of large dimensions are carried down annually towards the sea. Here the frost is so intense, that a dense sheet of ice is formed at low water, which, on the rise of the tide, is lifted up, broken, and thrown in heaps on the extensive shoals which border the estuary. When the tide recedes, this packed ice is exposed to a temperature sometimes 30° below zero, which freezes together all the loose pieces of ice, as well as the granitic and other boulders. The whole of these are often swept away by a high tide, or when the river is swollen by the melting of the snow in Spring. One huge block of granite, 15 feet long by 10 feet both in width and height, and estimated to contain 1500 cubic feet, was conveyed in this manner to some distance in the year 1837, its previous position being well known, as up to that time it had been used by Captain Bayfield as a mark for the surveying station.

These effects of frost, which are so noticeable on the St. Lawrence River above Quebec, are not evident on a smaller scale below that city, where the gulf rises and falls with the tide. In fact, it's in the estuary, between latitudes 47° and 49°, that the largest amounts of gravel and big boulders are carried down toward the sea each year. Here, the frost is so severe that a thick sheet of ice forms at low tide, which, when the tide comes in, gets lifted, broken, and piled up on the large shoals along the estuary. When the tide goes out, this packed ice is exposed to temperatures sometimes 30° below zero, freezing together all the loose ice pieces as well as the granite and other boulders. All of these are often swept away by high tides or when the river swells from melting snow in the spring. One massive granite block, 15 feet long and 10 feet wide and tall, estimated to contain 1,500 cubic feet, was moved this way to a distance in 1837, its previous location being well known, as it had been used by Captain Bayfield as a marker for the surveying station until that time.

Ground-ice.—When a current of cold air passes over the surface of a lake or stream it abstracts from it a quantity of heat, and the specific gravity of the water being thereby increased, the cooled portion sinks. This circulation may continue until the whole body of fluid has been cooled down to the temperature of 40° F., after which, if the cold increase, the vertical movement ceases, the water which is uppermost expands and floats over the heavier fluid below, and when it has attained a temperature of 32° Fahr. it sets into a sheet of ice. It should seem therefore impossible, according to this law of congelation, that ice should ever form at the bottom of a river; and yet such is the fact, and many speculations have been hazarded to account for so singular a phenomenon. M. Arago is of opinion that the mechanical action of a running 222 stream produces a circulation by which the entire body of water is mixed up together, and cooled alike, and the whole being thus reduced to the freezing point, ice begins to form at the bottom for two reasons, first, because there is less motion there, and secondly, because the water is in contact with solid rock or pebbles which have a cold surface.285 Whatever explanation we adopt, there is no doubt of the fact, that in countries where the intensity and duration of the cold is great, rivers and torrents acquire an increase of carrying power by the formation of what is called ground-ice. Even in the Thames we learn from Dr. Plott that pieces of this kind of ice, having gravel frozen on to their under side, rise up from the bottom in winter, and float on the surface. In the Siberian rivers, Weitz describes large stones as having been brought up from the river's bed in the same manner, and made to float.286

Ground ice.—When a cold air current moves over the surface of a lake or stream, it takes away some heat, causing the water's specific gravity to increase, which makes the cooler water sink. This circulation can continue until the entire body of water has cooled to 40° F. After that, if the cold continues, the vertical movement stops, the water on top expands, and floats over the denser water below. When it reaches a temperature of 32° F, it freezes into a sheet of ice. According to this freezing principle, it seems impossible for ice to form at the bottom of a river; however, this is actually the case, and many theories have been proposed to explain this unusual phenomenon. M. Arago believes that the mechanical motion of a flowing stream creates a circulation that mixes the entire body of water, cooling it uniformly. With the whole body reduced to freezing point, ice starts to form at the bottom for two reasons: first, there is less movement there, and second, the water is in contact with cold solid rock or pebbles.285 Whatever explanation we accept, it's clear that in regions where the cold is intense and prolonged, rivers and streams increase their carrying power through the formation of what is known as ground ice. Even in the Thames, Dr. Plott reports that pieces of this ice, with gravel frozen to their underside, rise from the bottom in winter and float on the surface. In the Siberian rivers, Weitz describes large stones being brought up from the riverbed in the same way and made to float.286

Glaciers.—In the temperate zone, the snow lies for months in winter on the summit of every high mountain, while in the arctic regions, a long summer's day of half a year's duration is insufficient to melt the snow, even on land just raised above the level of the sea. It is therefore not surprising, since the atmosphere becomes colder in proportion as we ascend in it, that there should be heights, even in tropical countries, where the snow never melts. The lowest limit to which the perpetual snow extends downwards, from the tops of mountains at the equator, is an elevation of not less than 16,000 feet above the sea; while in the Swiss Alps, in lat. 46° N. it reaches as low as 8,500 feet above the same level, the loftier peaks of the Alpine chain being from 12,000 to 15,000 feet high. The frozen mass augmenting from year to year would add indefinitely to the altitude of alpine summits, were it not relieved by its descent through the larger and deeper valleys to regions far below the general snow-line. To these it slowly finds its way in the form of rivers of ice, called glaciers, the consolidation of which is produced by pressure, and by the congelation of water infiltered into the porous mass, which is always undergoing partial liquefaction, and receiving in summer occasional showers of rain on its surface. In a day of hot sunshine, or mild rain, innumerable rills of pure and sparkling water run in icy channels along the surface of the glaciers, which in the night shrink, and come to nothing. They are often precipitated in bold cascades into deep fissures in the ice, and contribute together with springs to form torrents, which flow in tunnels at the bottom of the glaciers for many a league, and at length issue at their extremities, from beneath beautiful caverns or arches. The waters of these streams are always densely charged with the finest mud, produced by the grinding of rock and sand under the weight of the moving mass. (See fig. 18.)

Glaciers.—In the temperate zone, snow stays for months on the tops of high mountains during winter, while in the Arctic regions, a long summer day lasting half a year isn’t enough to melt the snow, even on land that's just above sea level. It's not surprising that, since the atmosphere gets colder the higher we go, there are heights in tropical countries where the snow never melts. The lowest point where perpetual snow can be found, from the tops of mountains at the equator, is at least 16,000 feet above sea level; while in the Swiss Alps, at a latitude of 46° N, it goes down as low as 8,500 feet. The taller peaks of the Alpine range are between 12,000 and 15,000 feet high. The frozen mass that builds up year after year would keep increasing the height of the Alpine summits, if it weren't moved down through larger and deeper valleys to areas far below the general snow line. It slowly flows as rivers of ice, known as glaciers, formed by pressure and the freezing of water that seeps into the porous mass, which is always partially melting and occasionally gets rain on its surface in summer. On hot sunny days or during light rain, countless streams of pure, sparkling water flow in icy channels along the glacier’s surface, but at night they shrink away. These streams often plunge in bold cascades into deep crevices in the ice and together with springs form torrents that run in tunnels at the base of the glaciers for many miles, eventually emerging from under beautiful caverns or arches. The water from these streams is always heavily mixed with fine mud, produced by the grinding of rock and sand under the weight of the moving ice. (See fig. 18.)

Fig. 18.

Glacier with medial and lateral moraines and with terminal cave.

Glacier with medial and lateral moraines and with terminal cave

Glacier with middle and side moraines and with an end cave

The length of the Swiss glaciers is sometimes twenty miles, their width in the middle portion, where they are broadest, occasionally two or three miles; their depth or thickness sometimes more than 600 feet. When they descend steep slopes, and precipices, or are forced through narrow gorges, the ice is broken up, and assumes the most fantastic and picturesque forms, with lofty peaks and pinnacles, projecting above the general level. These snow-white masses are often relieved by a dark background of pines, as in the valley of Chamouni; and are not only surrounded with abundance of the wild rhododendron in full flower, but encroach still lower into the region of cultivation, and trespass on fields where the tobacco-plant is flourishing by the side of the peasant's hut.

The Swiss glaciers can be up to twenty miles long, with their widest parts sometimes spanning two or three miles. Their thickness can exceed 600 feet. As they flow down steep slopes and cliffs, or squeeze through narrow gorges, the ice breaks apart, forming incredibly unique and striking shapes, with tall peaks and pinnacles rising above the general landscape. These bright white masses are often set against a dark backdrop of pine trees, like in the valley of Chamouni, and are surrounded by vibrant wild rhododendrons in full bloom. They also push further down into cultivated areas, overlapping with fields where tobacco plants thrive next to the peasants' homes.

The cause of glacier motion has of late been a subject of careful investigation and much keen controversy. Although a question of physics, rather than of geology, it is too interesting to allow me to pass it by without some brief mention. De Saussure, whose travels in the Alps are full of original observations, as well as sound and comprehensive general views, conceived that the weight of the ice might be sufficient to urge it down the slope of the valley, if the sliding motion were aided by the water flowing at the bottom. For this "gravitation theory" Charpentier, followed by Agassiz, substituted the hypothesis of dilatation. The most solid ice is always permeable to water, and penetrated224 by innumerable fissures and capillary tubes, often extremely minute. These tubes imbibe the aqueous fluid during the day, which freezes, it is said, in the cold of the night, and expands while in the act of congelation. The distension of the whole mass exerts an immense force, tending to propel the glacier in the direction of least resistance—"in other words, down the valley." This theory was opposed by Mr. Hopkins on mathematical and mechanical grounds, in several able papers. Among other objections, he pointed out that the friction of so enormous a body as a glacier on its bed is so great, that the vertical direction would always be that of least resistance, and if a considerable distension of the mass should take place, by the action of freezing, it would tend to increase its thickness, rather than accelerate its downward progress. He also contended (and his arguments were illustrated by many ingenious experiments), that a glacier can move along an extremely slight slope, solely by the influence of gravitation, owing to the constant dissolution of ice in contact with the rocky bottom, and the number of separate fragments into which the glacier is divided by fissures, so that freedom of motion is imparted to its several parts somewhat resembling that of an imperfect fluid. To this view Professor James Forbes objected, that gravitation would not supply an adequate cause for the sliding of solid ice down slopes having an inclination of no more than four or five degrees, still less would it explain how the glacier advances where the channel expands and contracts. The Mer de Glace in Chamouni, for example, after being 2000 yards wide, passes through a strait only 900 yards in width. Such a gorge, it is contended, would be choked up by the advance of any solid mass, even if it be broken up into numerous fragments. The same acute observer remarked, that water in the fissures and pores of glaciers cannot, and does not part with its latent heat, so as to freeze every night to a great depth, or far in the interior of the mass. Had the dilatation theory been true, the chief motion of the glacier would have occurred about sunset, when the freezing of the water must be greatest, and it had, in fact, been at first assumed by those who favored that hypothesis, that the mass moved faster at the sides, where the melting of ice was promoted by the sun's heat, reflected from boundary precipices.

The reason glaciers move has recently become a topic of serious study and lively debate. While it’s more about physics than geology, it’s too fascinating to ignore without a quick mention. De Saussure, who made original observations during his travels in the Alps and offered sound and broad perspectives, believed that the weight of the ice could push it down the valley if the sliding motion was helped by water flowing underneath. Charpentier, later supported by Agassiz, replaced this "gravitation theory" with the idea of expansion. The densest ice is always permeable to water and filled with countless tiny cracks and capillary tubes. These tubes absorb water during the day, which is said to freeze at night and expand as it freezes. This expansion creates tremendous force, pushing the glacier in the direction of least resistance—essentially, down the valley. Mr. Hopkins challenged this theory on mathematical and mechanical grounds in several strong papers. He argued that the friction of such a massive glacier against its base is so significant that the vertical direction would be the path of least resistance. He contended that if there was significant expansion due to freezing, it would make the glacier thicker instead of speeding up its descent. He also argued (and backed it up with clever experiments) that a glacier can move down a very gentle slope purely because of gravity, due to the constant melting of ice at the rocky bottom and the many fragments the glacier breaks into, allowing its parts to move somewhat like an imperfect fluid. Professor James Forbes responded to this idea, stating that gravity alone wouldn’t be enough to cause solid ice to slide down slopes that aren’t steeper than four or five degrees, let alone explain how the glacier makes progress where the channel narrows and widens. For instance, the Mer de Glace in Chamouni is about 2000 yards wide but then squeezes through a gap only 900 yards wide. This kind of narrowing, he argued, would block the advance of any solid mass, even if it were broken into many pieces. This keen observer also noted that water in the cracks and pores of glaciers can’t and doesn’t lose its latent heat enough to freeze deeply every night or deep within the glacier. If the expansion theory were correct, the main movement of the glacier would happen around sunset, when the freezing of the water should peak. Initially, those who supported that hypothesis even assumed the mass would move faster at the sides where sunlight melted the ice more effectively, reflecting off bordering cliffs.

Agassiz appears to have been the first to commence, in 1841, aided by a skilful engineer, M. Escher de la Linth, a series of exact measurements to ascertain the laws of glacier motion, and he soon discovered, contrary to his preconceived notions, that the stream of ice moved more slowly at the sides than at the centre, and faster in the middle region of the glacier than at its extremity.287 Professor James Forbes, who had joined Mr. Agassiz during his earlier investigations in the Alps, 225 undertook himself an independent series of experiments, which he followed up with great perseverance, to determine the laws of glacier motion. These he found to agree very closely with the laws governing the course of rivers, their progress being greater in the centre than at the sides, and more rapid at the surface than at the bottom. This fact was verified by carefully fixing a great number of marks in the ice, arranged in a straight line, which gradually assumed a beautiful curve, the middle part pointing down the glacier, and showing a velocity there, double or treble that of the lateral parts.288 He ascertained that the rate of advance by night was nearly the same as by day, and that even the hourly march of the icy stream could be detected, although the progress might not amount to more than six or seven inches in twelve hours. By the incessant though invisible advance of the marks placed on the ice, "time," says Mr. Forbes, "was marked out as by a shadow on a dial, and the unequivocal evidence which I obtained, that even while walking on a glacier we are, day by day, and hour by hour, imperceptibly carried on by the resistless flow of the icy stream, filled me with admiration." (Travels in the Alps, p. 133.) In order to explain this remarkable regularity of motion, and its obedience to laws so strictly analogous to those of fluids, the same writer proposed the theory that the ice, instead of being solid and compact, is a viscous or plastic body, capable of yielding to great pressure, and the more so in proportion as its temperature is higher, and as it approaches more nearly to the melting point. He endeavors to show that this hypothesis will account for many complicated phenomena, especially for a ribboned or veined structure which is everywhere observable in the ice, and might be produced by lines of discontinuity, arising from the different rates at which the various portions of the semi-rigid glacier advance and pass each other. Many examples are adduced to prove that a glacier can model itself to the form of the ground over which it is forced, exactly as would happen if it possessed a certain ductility, and this power of yielding under intense pressure, is shown not to be irreconcilable with the idea of the ice being sufficiently compact to break into fragments, when the strain upon its parts is excessive; as where the glacier turns a sharp angle, or descends upon a rapid or convex slope. The increased velocity in summer is attributed partly to the greater plasticity of the ice, when not exposed to intense cold, and partly to the hydrostatic pressure of the water in the capillary tubes, which imbibe more of this liquid in the hot season.

Agassiz seems to have been the first to start, in 1841, with the help of a skilled engineer, M. Escher de la Linth, a series of accurate measurements to determine the laws of glacier movement. He quickly found, against his initial beliefs, that the flow of ice moved more slowly at the edges than in the center and faster in the middle part of the glacier than at its ends.287 Professor James Forbes, who had joined Mr. Agassiz during his earlier studies in the Alps, 225 conducted his own independent experiments, which he pursued with great determination, to establish the laws of glacier motion. He found these laws to closely match those governing river flow, with movement being greater in the center than at the edges and faster at the surface than at the bottom. This was confirmed by carefully marking a large number of points in the ice, arranged in a straight line, which gradually formed a beautiful curve, the middle portion pointing down the glacier and showing a velocity there that was double or triple that of the lateral parts.288 He determined that the rate of advance at night was nearly the same as during the day, and that even the hourly movement of the ice stream could be seen, although the progress might only amount to six or seven inches over twelve hours. By the constant but invisible movement of the marks on the ice, "time," Mr. Forbes states, "was marked out like a shadow on a dial, and the clear evidence I obtained—that even while walking on a glacier we are, day by day, and hour by hour, imperceptibly carried along by the unstoppable flow of the icy stream—filled me with admiration." (Travels in the Alps, p. 133.) To explain this remarkable consistency of motion, and its adherence to laws so similar to those of fluids, the same writer proposed that the ice, rather than being solid and compact, is a viscous or plastic material, capable of yielding under great pressure, especially as its temperature rises and approaches the melting point. He tries to show that this hypothesis can explain many complex phenomena, particularly the ribbon-like or veined structure that is commonly seen in the ice, which might arise from lines of discontinuity due to the differing rates at which various parts of the semi-rigid glacier move and interact. He provides numerous examples to demonstrate that a glacier can adapt its shape to the terrain over which it flows, just as if it had a certain level of ductility. This ability to yield under intense pressure is shown to be compatible with the idea that the ice can be compact enough to break into fragments when the strain on its parts becomes too much; for instance, when the glacier turns a sharp corner or descends a steep or convex slope. The increased speed in summer is attributed partly to the greater plasticity of the ice when it isn't exposed to intense cold and partly to the hydrostatic pressure of water in the capillary tubes, which absorbs more of this liquid during the hot season.

On the assumption of the ice being a rigid mass, Mr. Hopkins attributed the more rapid motions in the centre to the unequal rate at which the broad stripes of ice, intervening between longitudinal fissures, advance; but besides that there are parts of the glacier where no such fissures exist, such a mode of progression, says Mr. Forbes, would cause the borders of large transverse rents or "crevasses," to be jagged like a 226 saw, instead of being perfectly even and straight-edged.289 An experiment recently made by Mr. Christie, secretary to the Royal Society, appears to demonstrate that ice, under great pressure, possesses a sufficient degree of moulding and self-adapting power to allow it to be acted upon, as if it were a pasty substance. A hollow shell of iron an inch and a half thick, the interior being ten inches in diameter, was filled with water, in the course of a severe winter, and exposed to the frost, with the fuze-hole uppermost. A portion of the water expanded in freezing, so as to protrude a cylinder of ice from the fuze-hole; and this cylinder continued to grow inch by inch in proportion as the central nucleus of water froze. As we cannot doubt that an outer shell of ice is first formed, and then another within, the continued rise of the column through the fuze-hole must proceed from the squeezing of successive shells of ice concentrically formed, through the narrow orifice; and yet the protruded cylinder consisted of entire, and not fragmentary ice.290

Assuming the ice is a solid mass, Mr. Hopkins suggested that the quicker movements in the center are due to the uneven speed at which the wide bands of ice between the long cracks move forward. However, there are sections of the glacier where there aren’t any cracks; according to Mr. Forbes, this type of movement would make the edges of large transverse cracks or "crevasses" jagged like a saw, instead of being completely smooth and straight. 226 An experiment recently conducted by Mr. Christie, secretary of the Royal Society, seems to show that ice, under high pressure, has enough ability to mold and adapt on its own to act like a soft substance. A hollow iron shell that was one and a half inches thick, with an interior diameter of ten inches, was filled with water during a harsh winter and left out in the freezing temperatures, with the fuse hole on top. As the water froze, it expanded and pushed a cylinder of ice out through the fuse hole, and this cylinder kept growing inch by inch as the central core of water froze. Since we can’t doubt that an outer layer of ice forms first, followed by another layer inside, the upward movement of the column through the fuse hole must come from the pressure of the successive concentric layers of ice formed through the narrow opening; yet the protruding cylinder was made entirely of solid ice, not pieces.290

The agency of glaciers in producing permanent geological changes consists partly in their power of transporting gravel, sand, and huge stones to great distances, and partly in the smoothing, polishing, and scoring of their rocky channels, and the boundary walls of the valleys through which they pass. At the foot of every steep cliff or precipice in high Alpine regions, a talus is seen of rocky fragments detached by the alternate action of frost and thaw. If these loose masses, instead of accumulating on a stationary base, happen to fall upon a glacier, they will move along with it, and, in place of a single heap, they will form in the course of years a long stream of blocks. If a glacier be 20 miles long, and its annual progression about 500 feet, it will require about two centuries for a block thus lodged upon its surface to travel down from the higher to the lower regions, or to the extremity of the icy mass. This terminal point remains usually unchanged from year to year, although every part of the ice is in motion, because the liquefaction by heat is just sufficient to balance the onward movement of the glacier, which may be compared to an endless file of soldiers, pouring into a breach, and shot down as fast as they advance.

The role of glaciers in creating permanent geological changes comes partly from their ability to carry gravel, sand, and large rocks over long distances, and partly from their action of smoothing, polishing, and scraping their rocky paths and the boundaries of the valleys they move through. At the base of every steep cliff or drop in high Alpine areas, you can see a pile of rocky fragments that have come loose due to the alternating effects of freezing and thawing. If these loose rocks, instead of piling up on a stable surface, happen to fall onto a glacier, they will move along with it, and over the years they will create a long stream of blocks rather than a single pile. If a glacier is 20 miles long, and it moves about 500 feet each year, it will take around two centuries for a block that ends up on its surface to slide down from the higher areas to the lower regions or the end of the ice mass. This endpoint usually stays the same from year to year, even though every part of the ice is moving, because the melting caused by heat is just enough to match the glacier's forward motion, which can be compared to an endless line of soldiers advancing into a breach, falling as quickly as they push forward.

The stones carried along on the ice are called in Switzerland the "moraines" of the glacier. There is always one line of blocks on each side or edge of the icy stream, and often several in the middle, where they are arranged in long ridges or mounds, often several yards high. (See fig. 18, p. 223.) The cause of these "medial moraines" was first explained by Agassiz, who referred them to the confluence of tributary glaciers.291 Upon the union of two streams of ice, the right lateral moraine 227 of one of the streams comes in contact with the left lateral moraine of the other, and they afterwards move on together, in the centre, if the confluent glaciers are equal in size, or nearer to one side if unequal.

The stones that are carried along by the ice are known as "moraines" in Switzerland. There is usually one line of blocks on each side or edge of the icy stream, and sometimes several in the middle, where they form long ridges or mounds, often several yards high. (See fig. 18, p. 223.) The reason for these "medial moraines" was first explained by Agassiz, who attributed them to the merging of tributary glaciers.291 When two ice streams unite, the right lateral moraine of one stream comes into contact with the left lateral moraine of the other, and they then move forward together, typically in the center if the merging glaciers are the same size, or slightly to one side if they are not.

All sand and fragments of soft stone which fall through fissures and reach the bottom of the glaciers, or which are interposed between the glacier and the steep sides of the valley, are pushed along, and ground down into mud, while the larger and harder fragments have their angles worn off. At the same time the fundamental and boundary rocks are smoothed and polished, and often scored with parallel furrows, or with lines and scratches produced by hard minerals, such as crystals of quartz, which act like the diamond upon glass.292 This effect is perfectly different from that caused by the action of water, or a muddy torrent forcing along heavy fragments; for when stones are fixed firmly in the ice, and pushed along by it under great pressure, in straight lines, they scoop out long rectilinear furrows or grooves parallel to each other.293 The discovery of such markings at various heights far above the surface of the existing glaciers and for miles beyond their present terminations, affords geological evidence of the former extension of the ice beyond its present limits in Switzerland and other countries.

All the sand and pieces of soft stone that fall through cracks and reach the bottom of glaciers, or are stuck between the glacier and the steep valley sides, get pushed along and ground down into mud, while the larger and tougher pieces have their edges smoothed out. At the same time, the underlying and surrounding rocks are smoothed and polished, often showing parallel grooves or scratches made by harder minerals, like quartz crystals, which act like diamonds on glass.292 This effect is completely different from what happens when water or a muddy torrent moves heavy stones; when rocks are firmly embedded in the ice and pushed along under high pressure in straight lines, they carve out long, parallel grooves.293 The discovery of such markings at various elevations far above the current glacier surfaces and miles beyond their present ends provides geological evidence that the ice once expanded beyond its current boundaries in Switzerland and other regions.

The moraine of the glacier, observes Charpentier, is entirely devoid of stratification, for there has been no sorting of the materials, as in the case of sand, mud, and pebbles, when deposited by running water. The ice transports indifferently, and to the same spots, the heaviest blocks and the finest particles, mingling all together, and leaving them in one confused and promiscuous heap wherever it melts.294

The glacier’s moraine, Charpentier notes, has no layers because the materials weren't sorted like sand, mud, and pebbles are when they're deposited by flowing water. Ice carries everything—both heavy boulders and tiny particles—to the same places, mixing them all together and leaving them in a jumbled pile wherever it melts.294

Icebergs.—In countries situated in high northern latitudes, like Spitzbergen, between 70° and 80° N., glaciers, loaded with mud and rock, descend to the sea, and there huge fragments of them float off and become icebergs. Scoresby counted 500 of these bergs drifting along in latitudes 69° and 70° N., which rose above the surface from the height of 100 to 200 feet, and measured from a few yards to a mile in circumference.295 Many of them were loaded with beds of earth and rock of such thickness, that the weight was conjectured to be from 50,000 to 100,000 tons. Specimens of the rocks were obtained, and among them were granite, gneiss, mica-schist, clay-slate, granular felspar, and greenstone. Such bergs must be of great magnitude; because the mass of ice below the level of the water is about eight times greater than that above. Wherever they are dissolved, it is evident that the "moraine" will fall to the bottom of the sea. In this manner may submarine valleys, mountains, and platforms become strewed over with gravel, sand, mud, and scattered blocks of foreign rock, of a nature perfectly dissimilar from all in the vicinity, and which may have been transported across unfathomable abysses. If the bergs happen to melt in still water, so that the earthy and stony materials may fall tranquilly to the bottom, 228 the deposit will probably be unstratified, like the terminal moraine of a glacier; but whenever the materials are under the influence of a current of water as they fall, they will be sorted and arranged according to their relative weight and size, and therefore more or less perfectly stratified.

Icebergs.—In countries located in the high northern latitudes, like Spitzbergen, between 70° and 80° N., glaciers full of mud and rock flow down to the sea, where large pieces break off and form icebergs. Scoresby counted 500 of these bergs drifting around latitudes 69° and 70° N., rising above the surface between 100 and 200 feet, and measuring from a few yards to a mile in circumference.295 Many of them carried layers of earth and rock so thick that their weight was estimated to be between 50,000 and 100,000 tons. Samples of the rocks were collected, including granite, gneiss, mica-schist, clay-slate, granular felspar, and greenstone. These bergs must be massive; the ice mass below the waterline is about eight times greater than what is above. Wherever they melt, it’s clear that the "moraine" will sink to the ocean floor. This process can scatter gravel, sand, mud, and various blocks of foreign rock—different from everything around them—across submarine valleys, mountains, and platforms, possibly transported across deep waters. If the bergs melt in still water, allowing the earth and stone materials to settle quietly to the bottom, the deposit is likely unstratified, similar to the terminal moraine of a glacier. However, if the materials are influenced by water currents as they fall, they will be sorted and arranged by weight and size, resulting in more or less well-defined strata.

In a former chapter it was stated that some ice islands have been known to drift from Baffin's Bay to the Azores, and from the South Pole to the immediate neighborhood of the Cape of Good Hope, so that the area over which the effects of moving ice may be experienced, comprehends a large portion of the globe.

In a previous chapter, it was mentioned that some ice islands have been known to drift from Baffin's Bay to the Azores, and from the South Pole to the area around the Cape of Good Hope, indicating that the region affected by moving ice covers a large part of the globe.

We learn from Von Buch that the most southern point on the continent of Europe at which a glacier comes down to the sea is in Norway, in lat. 67° N.296 But Mr. Darwin has shown, that they extend to the sea, in South America, in latitudes more than 20° nearer the equator than in Europe; as, for example, in Chili, where, in the Gulf of Penas, lat. 46° 40' S., or the latitude of central France; and in Sir George Eyre's Sound, in the latitude of Paris, they give origin to icebergs, which were seen in 1834 carrying angular pieces of granite, and stranding them in fiords, where the shores were composed of clay-slate.297 A large proportion, however, of the ice-islands seen floating both in the northern and southern hemispheres, are probably not generated by glaciers, but rather by the accumulation of coast ice. When the sea freezes at the base of a lofty precipice, the sheet of ice is prevented from adhering to the land by the rise and fall of the tide. Nevertheless, it often continues on the shore at the foot of the cliff, and receives accessions of drift snow blown from the land. Under the weight of this snow the ice sinks slowly if the water be deep, and the snow is gradually converted into ice by partial liquefaction and re-congelation. In this manner, islands of ice of great thickness and many leagues in length, originate, and are eventually blown out to sea by off-shore winds. In their interior are inclosed many fragments of stone which had fallen upon them from overhanging cliffs during their formation. Such floating icebergs are commonly flat-topped, but their lower portions are liable to melt in latitudes where the ocean at a moderate depth is usually warmer than the surface water and the air. Hence their centre of gravity changes continually, and they turn over and assume very irregular shapes.

We learn from Von Buch that the southernmost point in Europe where a glacier reaches the sea is in Norway, at latitude 67° N.296 But Mr. Darwin has shown that glaciers extend to the sea in South America at latitudes over 20° closer to the equator than in Europe; for example, in Chile, where in the Gulf of Penas, at latitude 46° 40' S., or the latitude of central France, and in Sir George Eyre's Sound, at the latitude of Paris, they create icebergs that were observed in 1834 carrying angular pieces of granite and stranding them in fjords with clay-slate shores.297 However, a significant portion of the floating ice seen in both the northern and southern hemispheres likely doesn’t come from glaciers but from accumulated coastal ice. When the sea freezes at the base of a high cliff, the ice sheet doesn’t stick to the land due to the tides. Still, it often remains on the shore at the bottom of the cliff and collects snow blown in from the land. Under the weight of this snow, the ice sinks slowly if the water is deep, and the snow gradually turns into ice through partial melting and refreezing. This process creates thick islands of ice that can stretch for many miles and are eventually pushed out to sea by offshore winds. These floating icebergs usually have flat tops, but their lower parts can melt in latitudes where the ocean is warmer than the surface water and air at moderate depths. As a result, their center of gravity constantly shifts, causing them to roll over and take on very irregular shapes.

In a voyage of discovery made in the antarctic regions in 1839, a dark-colored angular mass of rock was seen imbedded in an iceberg, drifting along in mid-ocean in lat. 61° S. That part of the rock which was visible was about 12 feet in height, and from 5 to 6 in width, but the dark color of the surrounding ice indicated that much more of the stone was concealed. A sketch made by Mr. Macnab, when the vessel was within a quarter of a mile of it, is now published.298 This iceberg, one of many observed at sea on the same day, was between 250 and 300 feet high, and was no less than 1400 miles from any certainly known land. It is exceedingly improbable, says Mr. Darwin, in his notice of this phenomenon, 229 that any land will hereafter be discovered within 100 miles of the spot, and it must be remembered that the erratic was still firmly fixed in the ice, and may have sailed for many a league farther before it dropped to the bottom.299

In a journey of exploration in the Antarctic regions in 1839, a dark, angular mass of rock was spotted embedded in an iceberg, drifting in the open ocean at latitude 61° S. The part of the rock that was visible measured about 12 feet high and 5 to 6 feet wide, but the dark color of the surrounding ice suggested that much more of the rock was hidden. A sketch created by Mr. Macnab when the ship was about a quarter of a mile away from it is now published.298 This iceberg, one of many seen at sea that same day, was between 250 and 300 feet tall and was at least 1400 miles from any reliably known land. Mr. Darwin noted regarding this phenomenon that it is extremely unlikely that any land will be discovered within 100 miles of this location, and it should be noted that the rock was still firmly lodged in the ice and may have drifted many more leagues before it eventually sank.299

Captain Sir James Ross, in his antarctic voyage in 1841, 42, and 43, saw multitudes of icebergs transporting stones and rocks of various sizes, with frozen mud, in high southern latitudes. His companion, Dr. J. Hooker, informs me that he came to the conclusion that most of the southern icebergs have stones in them, although they are usually concealed from view by the quantity of snow which falls upon them.

Captain Sir James Ross, during his Antarctic voyage in 1841, 42, and 43, saw countless icebergs carrying stones and rocks of different sizes, along with frozen mud, in the high southern latitudes. His companion, Dr. J. Hooker, told me that he concluded most of the southern icebergs contain stones, although they are usually hidden from sight by the amount of snow that falls on them.

In the account given by Messrs. Dease and Simpson, of their recent arctic discoveries, we learn that in lat. 71° N., long. 156° W., they found "a long low spit, named Point Barrow, composed of gravel and coarse sand, in some parts more than a quarter of a mile broad, which the pressure of the ice had forced up into numerous mounds, that, viewed from a distance, assumed the appearance of huge boulder rocks."300

In the report by Messrs. Dease and Simpson about their recent Arctic discoveries, we learn that at latitude 71° N, longitude 156° W, they found "a long, low spit called Point Barrow, made up of gravel and coarse sand, in some areas more than a quarter of a mile wide. The pressure from the ice had pushed it up into several mounds that, when seen from a distance, looked like massive boulder rocks."300

This fact is important, as showing how masses of drift ice, when stranding on submarine banks, may exert a lateral pressure capable of bending and dislocating any yielding strata of gravel, sand, or mud. The banks on which icebergs occasionally run aground between Baffin's Bay and Newfoundland, are many hundred feet under water, and the force with which they are struck will depend not so much on the velocity as the momentum of the floating ice-islands. The same berg is often carried away by a change of wind, and then driven back again upon the same bank, or it is made to rise and fall by the waves of the ocean, so that it may alternately strike the bottom with its whole weight, and then be lifted up again until it has deranged the superficial beds over a wide area. In this manner the geologist may account, perhaps, for the circumstance that in Scandinavia, Scotland, and other countries where erratics are met with, the beds of sand, loam, and gravel are often vertical, bent, and contorted into the most complicated folds, while the underlying strata, although composed of equally pliant materials, are horizontal. But some of these curvatures of loose strata may also have been due to repeated alternations of layers of gravel and sand, ice and snow, the melting of the latter having caused the intercalated beds of indestructible matter to assume their present anomalous position.

This fact is important because it demonstrates how large masses of drifting ice, when they become stranded on underwater banks, can exert lateral pressure strong enough to bend and dislocate any soft layers of gravel, sand, or mud. The banks where icebergs sometimes run aground between Baffin Bay and Newfoundland are many hundreds of feet underwater, and the force with which they hit will depend more on the momentum of the floating ice islands than on their speed. The same iceberg is often blown away by a change in the wind and then pushed back onto the same bank, or it can rise and fall with the ocean waves, alternately crashing down with its full weight and then being lifted up, causing it to disturb the surface beds over a wide area. This might explain why, in places like Scandinavia, Scotland, and other countries where erratic boulders are found, the layers of sand, loam, and gravel are often vertical, bent, and twisted into complex folds, while the underlying layers, made of similarly soft materials, remain horizontal. Some of these bends in the loose layers may also have resulted from repeated layers of gravel and sand, ice and snow, where the melting snow has caused the interspersed layers of durable materials to take on their current unusual positions.

There can be little doubt that icebergs must often break off the peaks and projecting points of submarine mountains, and must grate upon and polish their surface, furrowing or scratching them in precisely the same way as we have seen that glaciers act on the solid rocks over which they are propelled.301

There’s no doubt that icebergs often break off from the peaks and edges of underwater mountains, grinding against and smoothing their surfaces, scratching or scouring them just like we’ve observed glaciers do to the solid rocks they move over.301

230 To conclude: it appears that large stones, mud, and gravel are carried down by the ice of rivers, estuaries, and glaciers, into the sea, where the tides and currents of the ocean, aided by the wind, cause them to drift for hundreds of miles from the place of their origin. Although it will belong more properly to the seventh and eighth chapters to treat of the transportation of solid matter by the movements of the ocean, I shall add here what I have farther to say on this subject in connection with ice.

230 In conclusion, it seems that large rocks, mud, and gravel are carried downstream by the ice of rivers, estuaries, and glaciers into the sea, where ocean tides and currents, along with the wind, move them hundreds of miles away from their original location. While the transportation of solid matter through ocean movements will be covered more thoroughly in the seventh and eighth chapters, I will add some additional thoughts on this topic related to ice here.

The saline matter which sea-water holds in solution, prevents its congelation, except where the most intense cold prevails. But the drifting of the snow from the land often renders the surface-water brackish near the coast, so that a sheet of ice is readily formed there, and by this means a large quantity of gravel is frequently conveyed from place to place, and heavy boulders also, when the coast-ice is packed into dense masses. Both the large and small stones thus conveyed usually travel in one direction like shingle-beaches, and this was observed to take place on the coast of Labrador and Gulf of St. Lawrence, between the latitudes 50° and 60° N., by Capt. Bayfield, during his late survey. The line of coast alluded to is strewed over for a distance of 700 miles with ice-borne boulders, often 6 feet in diameter, which are for the most part on their way from north to south, or in the direction of the prevailing current. Some points on this coast have been observed to be occasionally deserted, and then again at another season thickly bestrewed with erratics.

The salt content in seawater keeps it from freezing, except in extremely cold conditions. However, the snow drifting from land can make the surface water brackish near the shore, allowing ice to form more easily there. This often leads to large amounts of gravel being moved from one place to another, as well as heavy boulders when the coastal ice piles up. Both large and small stones typically move in one direction, similar to shingle beaches. Captain Bayfield noticed this happening along the coasts of Labrador and the Gulf of St. Lawrence, between latitudes 50° and 60° N, during his recent survey. The coastline mentioned is littered with ice-drifted boulders, often six feet in diameter, that primarily travel from north to south, aligned with the dominant current. Some areas along this coast have been seen to be occasionally empty, only to be filled with erratic stones during different seasons.

Fig. 19.Boulders, chiefly of granite, stranded by ice.

Boulders, chiefly of granite, stranded by ice on the coast of Labrador, between lat. 50° and 60° N. (Lieut. Bowen, R. N.)

Boulders, mainly made of granite, left behind by ice along the coast of Labrador, between lat. 50° and 60° N. (Lieut. Bowen, R. N.)

The accompanying drawing (fig. 19), for which I am indebted to Lieut. Bowen, R. N., represents the ordinary appearance of the Labrador coast, between the latitudes of 50° and 60° N. Countless blocks, chiefly granitic, and of various sizes, are seen lying between high and low-water 231 mark. Capt. Bayfield saw similar masses carried by ice through the Straits of Belle Isle, between Newfoundland and the American continent, which he conceives may have travelled in the course of years from Baffin's Bay, a distance which may be compared in our hemisphere to the drifting of erratics from Lapland and Iceland as far south as Germany, France, and England.

The accompanying drawing (fig. 19), for which I am grateful to Lieut. Bowen, R. N., shows what the Labrador coast typically looks like, between latitudes 50° and 60° N. Numerous blocks, mostly granite, and varying in size, are found lying between the high and low-water marks. 231 Capt. Bayfield observed similar masses moved by ice through the Straits of Belle Isle, between Newfoundland and the American mainland, which he thinks may have drifted over years from Baffin's Bay—a distance that can be compared, in our hemisphere, to the movement of erratics from Lapland and Iceland all the way down to Germany, France, and England.

It may be asked in what manner have these blocks been originally detached? We may answer that some have fallen from precipitous cliffs, others have been lifted up from the bottom of the sea, adhering by their tops to the ice, while others have been brought down by rivers and glaciers.

It might be questioned how these blocks were originally separated. We can respond that some have fallen from steep cliffs, others have been raised from the ocean floor, sticking to the ice at their tops, while others have been transported by rivers and glaciers.

The erratics of North America are sometimes angular, but most of them have been rounded either by friction or decomposition. The granite of Canada, as before remarked (p. 221 ), has a tendency to concentric exfoliation, and scales off in spheroidal coats when exposed to the spray of the sea during severe frosts. The range of the thermometer in that country usually exceeds, in the course of the year, 100°, and sometimes 120° F.; and, to prevent the granite used in the buildings of Quebec from peeling off in winter, it is necessary to oil and paint the squared stones.

The erratics of North America can be angular, but most are rounded either by friction or decay. The granite in Canada, as mentioned before (p. 221), tends to exfoliate in concentric layers and peels off in rounded sheets when exposed to sea spray during harsh frosts. The temperature range in that country typically exceeds 100°F over the course of the year, and sometimes goes as high as 120°F. To stop the granite used in the buildings of Quebec from flaking off in winter, it’s essential to oil and paint the cut stones.

In parts of the Baltic, such as the Gulf of Bothnia, where the quantity of salt in the water amounts in general to one fourth only of that in the ocean, the entire surface freezes over in winter to the depth of 5 or 6 feet. Stones are thus frozen in, and afterwards lifted up about 3 feet perpendicularly on the melting of the snow in summer, and then carried by floating ice-islands to great distances. Professor Von Baer states, in a communication on this subject to the Academy of St. Petersburg, that a block of granite, weighing a million of pounds, was carried by ice during the winter of 1837-8 from Finland to the island of Hockland, and two other huge blocks were transported about the years 1806 and 1814 by packed ice on the south coast of Finland, according to the testimony of the pilots and inhabitants, one block having travelled about a quarter of a mile, and lying about 18 feet above the level of the sea.302

In parts of the Baltic, like the Gulf of Bothnia, where the salt content in the water is generally only a quarter of that in the ocean, the entire surface freezes over in winter, reaching depths of 5 or 6 feet. This causes stones to become frozen in the ice, and when the snow melts in summer, they get lifted about 3 feet up. Then, they are carried by floating ice islands over long distances. Professor Von Baer noted in a report to the Academy of St. Petersburg that during the winter of 1837-8, a granite block weighing a million pounds was moved by ice from Finland to Hockland Island. Additionally, according to local pilots and residents, two other massive blocks were transported around 1806 and 1814 by packed ice along the south coast of Finland, with one block traveling about a quarter of a mile and sitting around 18 feet above sea level.302

More recently Dr. Forchhammer has shown that in the Sound, the Great Belt, and other places near the entrance of the Baltic, ground-ice forms plentifully at the bottom and then rises to the surface, charged with sand and gravel, stones and sea-weed. Sheets of ice, also, with included boulders, are driven up on the coast during storms, and "packed" to a height of 50 feet. To the motion of such masses, but still more to that of the ground-ice, the Danish professor attributes the striation of rocky surfaces, forming the shores and bed of the sea, and he relates a striking fact to prove that large quantities of rocky fragments are annually carried by ice out of the Baltic. "In the year 1807," he says, "at the time of the bombardment of the Danish fleet, an English sloop-of-war, riding at anchor in the roads at Copenhagen, blew up. In 232 1844, or thirty-seven years afterwards, one of our divers, known to be a trustworthy man, went down to save whatever might yet remain in the shipwrecked vessel. He found the space between decks entire, but covered with blocks from 6 to 8 cubic feet in size, and some of them heaped one upon the other. He also affirmed, that all the sunk ships which he had visited in the Sound, were in like manner strewed over with blocks."

More recently, Dr. Forchhammer has demonstrated that in the Sound, the Great Belt, and other areas near the entrance of the Baltic, ground ice forms abundantly on the bottom and then rises to the surface, carrying sand, gravel, stones, and seaweed with it. During storms, sheets of ice, which include boulders, are pushed onto the coast and "packed" to a height of 50 feet. The Danish professor attributes the striation of rocky surfaces that make up the shores and seabed mainly to the movement of these masses, especially the ground ice. He also notes a remarkable fact to show that large amounts of rocky fragments are carried out of the Baltic by ice every year. "In the year 1807," he states, "during the bombardment of the Danish fleet, an English sloop-of-war, anchored in the roads at Copenhagen, exploded. In 232 1844, or thirty-seven years later, one of our divers, known to be reliable, went down to recover anything that might still be in the shipwrecked vessel. He found that the space between decks was intact but covered with blocks ranging from 6 to 8 cubic feet in size, some of which were stacked on top of each other. He also confirmed that all the sunken ships he had explored in the Sound were similarly scattered with blocks."

Dr. Forchhammer also informs us, that during an intense frost in February, 1844, the Sound was suddenly frozen over, and sheets of ice, driven by a storm, were heaped up at the bottom of the Bay of Täarbeijk, threatening to destroy a fishing-village on the shore. The whole was soon frozen together into one mass, and forced up on the beach, forming a mound more than 16 feet high, which threw down the walls of several buildings. "When I visited the spot next day, I saw ridges of ice, sand, and pebbles, not only on the shore, but extending far out into the bottom of the sea, showing how greatly its bed had been changed, and how easily, where it is composed of rock, it may be furrowed and streaked by stones firmly fixed in the moving ice."303

Dr. Forchhammer also tells us that during a severe frost in February 1844, the Sound suddenly froze over, and sheets of ice, pushed by a storm, piled up at the bottom of the Bay of Täarbeijk, threatening to destroy a fishing village on the shore. Everything quickly froze together into one mass and was pushed onto the beach, forming a mound more than 16 feet high, which knocked down the walls of several buildings. "When I visited the area the next day, I saw ridges of ice, sand, and pebbles, not just on the shore, but extending far out into the sea bed, showing how much it had changed and how easily, where it's made of rock, it can be furrowed and marked by stones fixed in the moving ice."303


CHAPTER XVI.

PHENOMENA OF SPRINGS.

Origin of Springs—Artesian wells—Borings at Paris—Distinct causes by which mineral and thermal waters may be raised to the surface—Their connection with volcanic agency—Calcareous springs—Travertin of the Elsa—Baths of San Vignone and of San Filippo, near Radicofani—Spheroidal structure in travertin—Lake of the Solfatara, near Rome—Travertin at Cascade of Tivoli—Gypseous, siliceous, and ferruginous springs—Brine springs—Carbonated springs—Disintegration of granite in Auvergne—Petroleum springs—Pitch lake of Trinidad.

Origin of Springs—Artesian wells—Drilling in Paris—Different reasons that mineral and thermal waters rise to the surface—Their link to volcanic activity—Calcium springs—Travertine of the Elsa—Baths of San Vignone and San Filippo, near Radicofani—Spheroidal structure in travertine—Lake of the Solfatara, near Rome—Travertine at the Cascade of Tivoli—Gypsum, silica, and iron-rich springs—Brine springs—Carbonated springs—Breakdown of granite in Auvergne—Oil springs—Pitch lake of Trinidad.

Origin of springs.—The action of running water on the surface of the land having been considered, we may next turn our attention to what may be termed "the subterranean drainage," or the phenomena of springs. Every one is familiar with the fact, that certain porous soils, such as loose sand and gravel, absorb water with rapidity, and that the ground composed of them soon dries up after heavy showers. If a well be sunk in such soils, we often penetrate to considerable depths before we meet with water; but this is usually found on our approaching the lower parts of the formation, where it rests on some impervious bed; for here the water, unable to make its way downwards in a direct line, accumulates as in a reservoir, and is ready to ooze out into any opening which may be made, in the same manner as we see the salt water flow into, and fill, any hollow which we dig in the sands of the shore at low tide.

Origin of springs.—Having looked at how running water affects the surface of the land, we can now focus on what we might call "subterranean drainage," or the phenomena of springs. Everyone knows that certain porous soils, like loose sand and gravel, quickly absorb water, and that the ground made up of these materials dries out fast after heavy rain. When we dig a well in such soils, we often have to go down quite a bit before we hit water; but this is usually found as we get closer to the lower layers of the formation, where it sits on some solid layer. Here, the water, unable to flow down directly, collects like in a reservoir and is ready to seep out into any opening we create, just like we see saltwater flowing into and filling any hole we dig in the sand at the beach during low tide.

233 The facility with which water can percolate loose and gravelly soils is clearly illustrated by the effect of the tides in the Thames between Richmond and London. The river, in this part of its course, flows through a bed of gravel overlying clay, and the porous superstratum is alternately saturated by the water of the Thames as the tide rises, and then drained again to the distance of several hundred feet from the banks when the tide falls, so that the wells in this tract regularly ebb and flow.

233 The way water can easily seep through loose and gravelly soils is clearly shown by the impact of the tides in the Thames between Richmond and London. In this section, the river flows through a gravel bed that sits on clay, and the porous layer above it gets soaked with Thames water as the tide comes in, then drains back several hundred feet from the banks when the tide goes out, causing the wells in this area to regularly rise and fall.

If the transmission of water through a porous medium be so rapid, we cannot be surprised that springs should be thrown out on the side of a hill, where the upper set of strata consist of chalk, sand, or other permeable substances, while the subjacent are composed of clay or other retentive soils. The only difficulty, indeed, is to explain why the water does not ooze out everywhere along the line of junction of the two formations, so as to form one continuous land-soak, instead of a few springs only, and these far distant from each other. The principal cause of this concentration of the waters at a few points is, first, the frequency of rents and fissures, which act as natural drains; secondly, the existence of inequalities in the upper surface of the impermeable stratum, which lead the water, as valleys do on the external surface of a country, into certain low levels and channels.

If water moves through a porous material quickly, it's not surprising that springs appear on the side of a hill where the upper layers are made of chalk, sand, or other permeable materials, while the lower layers consist of clay or other water-retaining soils. The only challenge is to understand why the water doesn't leak out everywhere along the boundary of the two formations, creating one continuous soak in the land, rather than just a few springs that are far apart. The main reason for this gathering of water at specific points is, first, the presence of cracks and gaps, which act like natural drains; and second, the variations in the surface of the impermeable layer, which guide the water, much like valleys do on the surface of the land, into certain low spots and channels.

That the generality of springs owe their supply to the atmosphere is evident from this, that they become languid, or entirely cease to flow, after long droughts, and are again replenished after a continuance of rain. Many of them are probably indebted for the constancy and uniformity of their volume to the great extent of the subterranean reservoirs with which they communicate, and the time required for these to empty themselves by percolation. Such a gradual and regulated discharge is exhibited, though in a less perfect degree, in every great lake which is not sensibly affected in its level by sudden showers, but only slightly raised; so that its channel of efflux, instead of being swollen suddenly like the bed of a torrent, is enabled to carry off the surplus water gradually.

It's clear that most springs get their water from the atmosphere because they slow down or completely stop flowing after long dry spells, and they start flowing again after it rains for a while. Many springs probably maintain a steady flow and volume thanks to the large underground reservoirs they're connected to and the time it takes for these reservoirs to drain through filtration. You can see a similar, though less efficient, process in big lakes that aren't significantly impacted by sudden rain; instead of their levels rising quickly, they only go up slightly, allowing their outflow channels to carry away the extra water gradually.

Much light has been thrown, of late years, on the theory of springs, by the boring of what are called by the French "Artesian wells," because the method has long been known and practised in Artois; and it is now demonstrated that there are sheets, and in some places currents of fresh water, at various depths in the earth. The instrument employed in excavating these wells is a large augur, and the cavity bored is usually from three to four inches in diameter. If a hard rock is met with, it is first triturated by an iron rod, and the materials being thus reduced to small fragments or powder, are readily extracted. To hinder the sides of the well from falling in, as also to prevent the spreading of the ascending water in the surrounding soil, a jointed pipe is introduced, formed of wood in Artois, but in other countries more commonly of metal. It frequently happens that, after passing through hundreds of feet of retentive soils, a water-bearing stratum is at length pierced, 234 when the fluid immediately ascends to the surface, and flows over. The first rush of the water up the tube is often violent, so that for a time the water plays like a fountain, and then, sinking, continues to flow over tranquilly, or sometimes remains stationary at a certain depth below the orifice of the well. This spouting of the water in the first instance is probably owing to the disengagement of air and carbonic acid gas, for both of these have been seen to bubble up with the water.304

Recently, a lot of new information has come to light about the theory of springs, thanks to the drilling of what the French call "Artesian wells," a method that has been known and used in Artois for a long time. It's now proven that there are layers, and in some places, streams of fresh water at various depths within the earth. The tool used for digging these wells is a large auger, and the hole drilled is usually about three to four inches wide. If a hard rock is encountered, it is first broken up with an iron rod, and once the material is reduced to small pieces or powder, it's easily removed. To prevent the walls of the well from collapsing and to stop the rising water from spreading into the surrounding soil, a jointed pipe is inserted, which is made of wood in Artois but is more commonly made of metal in other countries. It often happens that after passing through hundreds of feet of impermeable soil, a water-bearing layer is finally reached, 234 causing the water to flow up to the surface and over. The initial surge of water rushing up the pipe can be quite forceful, creating a fountain-like effect for a time, and then it calms down to flow steadily or sometimes remains at a certain level below the well's opening. This initial spouting of water is likely due to the release of air and carbon dioxide gas, as both have been observed bubbling up alongside the water.304

At Sheerness, at the mouth of the Thames, a well was bored on a low tongue of land near the sea, through 300 feet of the blue clay of London, below which a bed of sand and pebbles was entered, belonging, doubtless, to the plastic clay formation; when this stratum was pierced, the water burst up with impetuosity, and filled the well. By another perforation at the same place, the water was found at the depth of 328 feet below the surface clay; it first rose rapidly to the height of 189 feet, and then, in the course of a few hours, ascended to an elevation of eight feet above the level of the ground. In 1824 a well was dug at Fulham, near the Thames, at the Bishop of London's, to the depth of 317 feet, which, after traversing the tertiary strata, was continued through 67 feet of chalk. The water immediately rose to the surface, and the discharge was about 50 gallons per minute. In the garden of the Horticultural Society at Chiswick, the borings passed through 19 feet of gravel, 242½ feet of clay and loam, and 67½ feet of chalk, and the water then rose to the surface from a depth of 329 feet.305 At the Duke of Northumberland's, above Chiswick, the borings were carried to the extraordinary depth of 620 feet, so as to enter the chalk, when a considerable volume of water was obtained, which rose four feet above the surface of the ground. In a well of Mr. Brooks, at Hammersmith, the rush of water from a depth of 360 feet was so great, as to inundate several buildings and do considerable damage; and at Tooting, a sufficient stream was obtained to turn a wheel, and raise the water to the upper stories of the houses.306 In 1838, the total supply obtained from the chalk near London was estimated at six million gallons a day, and, in 1851, at nearly double that amount, the increase being accompanied by an average fall of no less than two feet a year in the level to which the water rose. The water stood commonly, in 1822, at high-water mark, and had sunk in 1851 to 45, and in some wells to 65 feet below high-water mark.307 This fact shows the limited capacity of the subterranean reservoir. In the last of three wells bored through the chalk at Tours, to the depth of several hundred feet, the water rose 32 feet above the level of the soil, and the discharge amounted to 300 cubic yards of water every twenty-four hours.308

At Sheerness, at the mouth of the Thames, a well was drilled on a low piece of land near the sea, going through 300 feet of London’s blue clay. Beneath that, they hit a layer of sand and pebbles, likely part of the plastic clay formation. When this layer was reached, water burst up forcefully, filling the well. In another drilling at the same spot, water was found at a depth of 328 feet below the surface clay; it first rose quickly to 189 feet and then, over a few hours, climbed to eight feet above ground level. In 1824, a well was dug at Fulham, near the Thames, at the Bishop of London's property, reaching a depth of 317 feet, which passed through the tertiary layers and continued through 67 feet of chalk. The water rose immediately to the surface, with a flow of about 50 gallons per minute. In the garden of the Horticultural Society at Chiswick, the drilling went through 19 feet of gravel, 242½ feet of clay and loam, and 67½ feet of chalk, after which the water surged to the surface from a depth of 329 feet.305 At the Duke of Northumberland's, above Chiswick, the drilling reached an impressive depth of 620 feet to access the chalk, resulting in a significant volume of water that rose four feet above ground level. In Mr. Brooks' well at Hammersmith, the rush of water from a depth of 360 feet was so overwhelming that it flooded several buildings and caused notable damage; similarly, at Tooting, there was enough water to power a wheel and raise it to the upper floors of the houses.306 In 1838, the total water supply from the chalk near London was estimated at six million gallons a day, and by 1851, it was nearly double that amount, alongside an average drop of two feet per year in the level to which the water rose. In 1822, the water was typically at high-water mark but had fallen by 1851 to 45 feet, and in some wells, down to 65 feet below high-water mark.307 This indicates the limited capacity of the underground reservoir. In the last of three wells drilled through the chalk at Tours, reaching several hundred feet deep, the water rose 32 feet above the soil level, with a discharge of 300 cubic yards of water every twenty-four hours.308

By way of experiment, the sinking of a well was commenced at Paris 235 in 1834, which had reached, in November, 1839, a depth of more than 1600 English feet, and yet no water ascended to the surface. The government were persuaded by M. Arago to persevere, if necessary, to the depth of more than 2000 feet; but when they had descended above 1800 English feet below the surface, the water rose through the tube (which was about ten inches in diameter), so as to discharge half a million of gallons of limpid water every twenty-four hours. The temperature of the water increased at the rate of 1·8° F. for every 101 English feet, as they went down, the result agreeing very closely with the anticipations of the scientific advisers of this most spirited undertaking.

As an experiment, a well was started in Paris 235 in 1834, which by November 1839 had reached a depth of more than 1600 feet, yet no water came to the surface. The government was convinced by M. Arago to continue digging, if necessary, to a depth of over 2000 feet; but when they went down more than 1800 feet, water surged through the tube (which was about ten inches wide), discharging half a million gallons of clear water every 24 hours. The temperature of the water increased by 1.8°F for every 101 feet they descended, closely matching the predictions of the scientific advisors for this ambitious project.

Mr. Briggs, the British consul in Egypt, obtained water between Cairo and Suez, in a calcareous sand, at the depth of thirty feet; but it did not rise in the well.309 But other borings in the same desert, of variable depth, between 50 and 300 feet, and which passed through alternations of sand, clay, and siliceous rock, yielded water at the surface.310

Mr. Briggs, the British consul in Egypt, found water between Cairo and Suez in a sandy area at a depth of thirty feet; however, it didn't rise in the well.309 Other drilling in the same desert, varying in depth from 50 to 300 feet, and going through layers of sand, clay, and siliceous rock, produced water at the surface.310

The rise and overflow of the water in Artesian wells is generally referred, and apparently with reason, to the same principle as the play of an artificial fountain. Let the porous stratum or set of strata, a a, rest on the impermeable rock d, and be covered by another mass of an impermeable nature. The whole mass a a may easily, in such a position, become saturated with water, which may descend from its higher and exposed parts—a hilly region to which clouds are attracted, and where rain falls in abundance. Suppose that at some point, as at b, an opening be made, which gives a free passage upwards to the waters confined in a a, at so low a level that they are subjected to the pressure of a considerable column of water collected in the more elevated portion of the same stratum. The water will then rush out, just as the liquid from a large barrel which is tapped, and it will rise to a height corresponding to the level of its point of departure, or, rather, to a height which balances the pressure previously exerted by the confined waters against the roof and sides of the stratum or reservoir a a. In like manner, if there happen to be a natural fissure c, a spring will be produced at the surface on precisely the same principle.

The rise and overflow of water in Artesian wells is usually explained, and quite rightly, by the same principle as a man-made fountain. If the porous layer (or layers) a a sits on top of an impermeable rock d and is covered by another impermeable layer, the entire mass a a can easily become saturated with water. This water can come from higher, exposed areas like hilly regions where clouds gather and rainfall is plentiful. If we create an opening at some point, like at b, allowing the water trapped in a a to flow upward, it will be under pressure from a significant column of water in the higher part of the same layer. The water will then burst out, similar to how liquid spills from a large barrel when tapped, rising to a height that reflects where it started or to a height that balances the pressure exerted by the trapped water against the ceiling and sides of the layer a a. Similarly, if there happens to be a natural crack c, a spring will form at the surface based on the same principle.

Fig. 20.Artesian wells.

Among the causes of the failure of Artesian wells, we may mention those numerous rents and faults which abound in some rocks, and the 236 deep ravines and valleys by which many countries are traversed; for, when these natural lines of drainage exist, there remains a small quantity only of water to escape by artificial issues. We are also liable to be baffled by the great thickness either of porous or impervious strata, or by the dip of the beds, which may carry off the waters from the adjoining high lands to some trough in an opposite direction, as when the borings are made at the foot of an escarpment where the strata incline inwards, or in a direction opposite to the face of the cliffs.

Among the reasons for the failure of artesian wells, we can mention the numerous cracks and faults found in certain types of rock, as well as the deep ravines and valleys that cross many regions. When these natural drainage paths are present, only a small amount of water can flow out through artificial openings. We might also be challenged by the significant thickness of either porous or impermeable layers, or by the tilt of the beds, which can direct water from the nearby highlands into a trough in the opposite direction. This happens, for example, when boreholes are drilled at the base of a cliff where the layers slope inward or in the opposite direction of the cliff face.

The mere distance of hills or mountains need not discourage us from making trials; for the waters which fall on these higher lands readily penetrate to great depths through highly inclined or vertical strata, or through the fissures of shattered rocks, and after flowing for a great distance, must often reascend and be brought up again by other fissures, so as to approach the surface in the lower country. Here they may be concealed beneath the covering of undisturbed horizontal beds, which it may be necessary to pierce in order to reach them. It should be remembered, that the course of waters flowing under ground bears but a remote resemblance to that of rivers on the surface, there being, in the one case, a constant descent from a higher to a lower level from the source of the stream to the sea; whereas, in the other, the water may at one time sink far below the level of the ocean, and afterwards rise again high above it.

The distance of hills or mountains shouldn’t stop us from trying; the water that falls on these higher lands easily seeps down through steep or vertical layers, or through cracks in broken rocks. After traveling a long way underground, it often has to rise again through other cracks to get close to the surface in the lower areas. Here, it might be hidden beneath layers of undisturbed horizontal rock that we may need to drill through to access it. It's important to remember that the path of water flowing underground is quite different from the flow of rivers on the surface. In the former case, there’s a constant drop from a higher level to a lower level, from the stream's source to the sea. In contrast, underground water may sink well below sea level at times and then rise again above it.

Among other curious facts ascertained by aid of the borer, it is proved that in strata of different ages and compositions, there are often open passages by which the subterranean waters circulate. Thus, at St. Ouen, in France, five distinct sheets of water were intersected in a well, and from each of these a supply obtained. In the third waterbearing stratum, at the depth of 150 feet, a cavity was found in which the borer fell suddenly about a foot, and thence the water ascended in great volume.311 The same falling of the instrument, as in a hollow space, has been remarked in England and other countries. At Tours, in 1830, a well was perforated quite through the chalk, when the water suddenly brought up, from a depth of 364 feet, a great quantity of fine sand, with much vegetable matter and shells. Branches of a thorn several inches long, much blackened by their stay in the water, were recognized, as also the stems of marsh plants, and some of their roots, which were still white, together with the seeds of the same in a state of preservation, which showed that they had not remained more than three or four months in the water. Among the seeds were those of the marsh plant Galium uliginosum; and among the shells, a freshwater species (Planorbis marginatus), and some land species, as Helix rotundata, and H. striata. M. Dujardin, who, with others, observed this phenomenon, supposes that the waters had flowed from some valleys of Auvergne or the Vivarais since the preceding autumn.312

Among other interesting facts discovered with the borer, it has been shown that in layers of different ages and materials, there are often open channels that allow underground water to flow. For example, at St. Ouen in France, five distinct layers of water were found in a well, and we were able to draw supplies from each of them. In the third water-bearing layer, at a depth of 150 feet, a cavity was encountered where the borer dropped suddenly about a foot, and from there, water surged up in large quantities.311 The same drop of the instrument, similar to finding a hollow space, has been noted in England and other countries. In Tours, in 1830, a well was drilled completely through the chalk, and the water suddenly brought up from a depth of 364 feet a significant amount of fine sand, along with a lot of plant matter and shells. Branches of a thorn several inches long, darkened from their time in the water, were identified, as well as stems of marsh plants, with some roots still white, and seeds of the same plants in good condition, indicating they hadn't been in the water for more than three or four months. Among the seeds were those of the marsh plant Galium uliginosum; and among the shells were a freshwater species (Planorbis marginatus) and some land species like Helix rotundata and H. striata. M. Dujardin, who, along with others, observed this phenomenon, speculates that the waters have been flowing from some valleys of Auvergne or the Vivarais since the previous autumn.312

An analogous phenomenon is recorded at Reimke, near Bochum in 237 Westphalia, where the water of an Artesian well brought up, from a depth of 156 feet, several small fish, three or four inches long, the nearest streams in the country being at a distance of some leagues.313

An equivalent occurrence was noted at Reimke, near Bochum in 237 Westphalia, where the water from an Artesian well brought up several small fish, three to four inches long, from a depth of 156 feet, while the nearest streams in the area were several leagues away.313

In both cases it is evident that water had penetrated to great depths, not simply by filtering through a porous mass, for then it would have left behind the shells, fish, and fragments of plants, but by flowing through some open channels in the earth. Such examples may suggest the idea that the leaky beds of rivers are often the feeders of springs.

In both cases, it's clear that water had seeped to significant depths, not just by filtering through a porous material, as that would have left behind the shells, fish, and bits of plants, but by flowing through some open channels in the ground. Such examples might suggest that the leaking riverbeds often supply springs.

MINERAL AND THERMAL SPRINGS.

Almost all springs, even those which we consider the purest, are impregnated with some foreign ingredients, which, being in a state of chemical solution, are so intimately blended with the water as not to affect its clearness, while they render it, in general, more agreeable to our taste, and more nutritious than simple rain-water. But the springs called mineral contain an unusual abundance of earthy matter in solution, and the substances with which they are impregnated correspond remarkably with those evolved in a gaseous form by volcanoes. Many of these springs are thermal, i. e., their temperature is above the mean temperature of the place, and they rise up through all kinds of rock; as, for example, through granite, gneiss, limestone, or lava, but are most frequent in volcanic regions, or where violent earthquakes have occurred at eras comparatively modern.

Almost all springs, even those we think of as the purest, contain some foreign substances that, being in a state of chemical solution, are so well blended with the water that they don't affect its clarity. However, they generally make it taste better and more nutritious than plain rainwater. The springs known as mineral springs have an unusual amount of earthy matter dissolved in them, and the substances they're infused with closely resemble those released in gas form by volcanoes. Many of these springs are thermal, meaning their temperature is higher than the average for that location, and they flow up through various types of rock, such as granite, gneiss, limestone, or lava, but are most commonly found in volcanic areas or places that have experienced significant earthquakes in relatively recent times.

The water given out by hot springs is generally more voluminous and less variable in quantity at different seasons than that proceeding from any others. In many volcanic regions, jets of steam, called by the Italians "stufas," issue from fissures, at a temperature high above the boiling point, as in the neighborhood of Naples, and in the Lipari Isles, and are disengaged unceasingly for ages. Now, if such columns of steam, which are often mixed with other gases, should be condensed before reaching the surface by coming in contact with strata filled with cold water, they may give rise to thermal and mineral springs of every degree of temperature. It is, indeed, by this means only, and not by hydrostatic pressure, that we can account for the rise of such bodies of water from great depths; nor can we hesitate to admit the adequacy of the cause, if we suppose the expansion of the same elastic fluids to be sufficient to raise columns of lava to the lofty summits of volcanic mountains. Several gases, the carbonic acid in particular, are disengaged in a free state from the soil in many districts, especially in the regions of active or extinct volcanoes; and the same are found more or less intimately combined with the waters of all mineral springs, both cold and thermal. Dr. Daubeny and other writers have remarked, not only that these springs are most abundant in volcanic regions, but that when remote from them, their site usually coincides with the position of some 238 great derangement in the strata; a fault, for example, or great fissure, indicating that a channel of communication has been opened with the interior of the earth at some former period of local convulsion. It is also ascertained that at great heights in the Pyrenees and Himalaya mountains hot springs burst out from granitic rocks, and they are abundant in the Alps also, these chains having all been disturbed and dislocated at times comparatively modern, as can be shown by independent geological evidence.

The water from hot springs is usually more abundant and more consistent in quantity throughout the seasons than water from other sources. In many volcanic areas, jets of steam, known as "stufas" in Italian, emerge from cracks at temperatures significantly above boiling, like around Naples and the Lipari Islands, and have been continuously released for ages. If these steam columns, which are often mixed with other gases, were to condense before reaching the surface due to contact with layers of cold water, they could create thermal and mineral springs of various temperatures. This is indeed the only way to explain the rise of these bodies of water from great depths, rather than through hydrostatic pressure. We can't deny the adequacy of this cause, especially if we consider that the expansion of these gases could be enough to lift lava columns to the high peaks of volcanic mountains. Several gases, particularly carbon dioxide, are released freely from the ground in many areas, especially near active or extinct volcanoes, and they are often found in varying degrees of combination with the waters of all mineral springs, whether cold or thermal. Dr. Daubeny and other authors have noted that these springs are most plentiful in volcanic regions, but when located far from such areas, their locations typically align with significant geological disturbances, such as faults or large fissures, suggesting that a path to the Earth's interior was opened during some previous phase of local upheaval. It's also been confirmed that, at high altitudes in the Pyrenees and Himalayas, hot springs emerge from granite rocks, and they are also plentiful in the Alps, as these mountain ranges have all been disrupted and shifted during relatively recent geological times, as can be substantiated by independent geological evidence.

The small area of volcanic regions may appear, at first view, to present an objection to these views, but not so when we include earthquakes among the effects of igneous agency. A large proportion of the land hitherto explored by geologists can be shown to have been rent or shaken by subterranean movements since the oldest tertiary strata were formed. It will also be seen, in the sequel, that new springs have burst out, and others have had the volume of their waters augmented, and their temperature suddenly raised after earthquakes, so that the description of these springs might almost with equal propriety have been given under the head of "igneous causes," as they are agents of a mixed nature, being at once igneous and aqueous.

The small volcanic areas might initially seem to challenge these ideas, but that’s not the case when we take earthquakes into account as part of the effects of volcanic activity. A significant portion of the land that geologists have studied shows signs of being fractured or shaken by underground movements since the formation of the oldest tertiary layers. It will also become clear later that new springs have emerged, while others have seen their water volume increase and temperature suddenly rise after earthquakes. Thus, a description of these springs could almost just as appropriately fall under "volcanic causes," as they are a mix of both volcanic and water-related processes.

But how, it will be asked, can the regions of volcanic heat send forth such inexhaustible supplies of water? The difficulty of solving this problem would, in truth, be insurmountable, if we believed that all the atmospheric waters found their way into the basin of the ocean; but in boring near the shore we often meet with streams of fresh water at the depth of several hundred feet below the sea level; and these probably descend, in many cases, far beneath the bottom of the sea, when not artificially intercepted in their course. Yet, how much greater may be the quantity of salt water which sinks beneath the floor of the ocean, through the porous strata of which it is often composed, or through fissures rent in it by earthquakes. After penetrating to a considerable depth, this water may encounter a heat of sufficient intensity to convert it into vapor, even under the high pressure to which it would then be subjected. This heat would probably be nearest the surface in volcanic countries, and farthest from it in those districts which have been longest free from eruptions or earthquakes.

But how can areas with volcanic heat provide such an endless supply of water? This question seems difficult to answer, especially if we think that all the water in the atmosphere goes into the ocean's basin. However, when drilling near the shore, we often find fresh water streams hundreds of feet below sea level, and these likely extend much deeper beneath the ocean floor, unless they’re blocked in some way. And consider how much salt water might flow under the ocean floor through the porous layers it often consists of, or through cracks created by earthquakes. Once this water gets to a certain depth, it might hit heat intense enough to turn it into vapor, even with the high pressure it's under. This heat is likely closer to the surface in volcanic regions and farther away in areas that haven’t had eruptions or earthquakes for a long time.

It would follow from the views above explained, that there must be a twofold circulation of terrestrial waters; one caused by solar heat, and the other by heat generated in the interior of our planet. We know that the land would be unfit for vegetation, if deprived of the waters raised into the atmosphere by the sun; but it is also true that mineral springs are powerful instruments in rendering the surface subservient to the support of animal and vegetable life. Their heat is said to promote the development of the aquatic tribes in many parts of the ocean, and the substances which they carry up from the bowels of the earth to the habitable surface, are of a nature and in a form which adapts them peculiarly for the nutrition of animals and plants.

It follows from the views explained above that there must be two types of circulation of Earth's waters: one driven by solar heat and the other by heat generated within our planet. We know that land wouldn't be suitable for vegetation if it were deprived of the water evaporated into the atmosphere by the sun; however, it is also true that mineral springs play a significant role in making the surface suitable for supporting both animal and plant life. Their heat is believed to enhance the development of aquatic species in many parts of the ocean, and the substances they bring up from deep within the Earth are in a form and of a nature that makes them especially beneficial for the nourishment of animals and plants.

As these springs derive their chief importance to the geologist from 239 the quantity and quality of the earthy materials which, like volcanoes, they convey from below upwards, they may properly be considered in reference to the ingredients which they hold in solution. These consist of a great variety of substances; but chiefly salts with bases of lime, magnesia, alumine, and iron, combined with carbonic, sulphuric, and muriatic acids. Muriate of soda, silica, and free carbonic acid are frequently present; also springs of petroleum, or liquid bitumen, and of naphtha.

As these springs are mainly significant to geologists because of the quantity and quality of the soil materials they bring up from below, much like volcanoes, it's appropriate to consider them in terms of the substances they carry in solution. These substances include a wide range of materials, primarily salts with bases of lime, magnesium, aluminum, and iron, paired with carbonic, sulfuric, and hydrochloric acids. Sodium chloride, silica, and free carbonic acid are often found as well, along with springs of petroleum or liquid bitumen, and naphtha.

Calcareous springs.—Our first attention is naturally directed to springs which are highly charged with calcareous matter, for these produce a variety of phenomena of much interest in geology. It is known that rain-water collecting carbonic acid from the atmosphere has the property of dissolving the calcareous rocks over which it flows, and thus, in the smallest ponds and rivulets, matter is often supplied for the earthy secretions of testacea, and for the growth of certain plants on which they feed. But many springs hold so much carbonic acid in solution, that they are enabled to dissolve a much larger quantity of calcareous matter than rain-water; and when the acid is dissipated in the atmosphere, the mineral ingredients are thrown down, in the form of porous tufa or of more compact travertin.314

Calcareous springs.—Our attention is naturally drawn to springs that are rich in calcareous material, as they create a variety of fascinating geological phenomena. It's known that rainwater, which collects carbon dioxide from the atmosphere, can dissolve the calcareous rocks it flows over. As a result, even in the smallest ponds and streams, materials are often provided for the earthy secretions of shellfish and for the growth of certain plants that they feed on. However, many springs contain so much carbon dioxide that they can dissolve a significantly larger amount of calcareous material than rainwater can. When the acid is released into the atmosphere, the mineral components are deposited as porous tufa or more solid travertine.314

Auvergne.—Calcareous springs, although most abundant in limestone districts, are by no means confined to them, but flow out indiscriminately from all rock formations. In central France, a district where the primary rocks are unusually destitute of limestone, springs copiously charged with carbonate of lime rise up through the granite and gneiss. Some of these are thermal, and probably derive their origin from the deep source of volcanic heat, once so active in that region. One of these springs, at the northern base of the hill upon which Claremont is built, issues from volcanic peperino, which rests on granite. It has formed, by its incrustations, an elevated mound of travertin, or white concretionary limestone, 240 feet in length, and, at its termination, sixteen feet high and twelve wide. Another encrusting spring in the same department, situated at Chaluzet, near Pont Gibaud, rises in a gneiss country, at the foot of a regular volcanic cone, at least twenty miles from any calcareous rock. Some masses of tufaceous deposit, produced by this spring, have an oolitic texture.

Auvergne.—Calcareous springs, while most common in limestone areas, aren’t limited to those regions and can emerge from all types of rock formations. In central France, where the primary rocks lack limestone, springs rich in calcium carbonate bubble up through granite and gneiss. Some of these springs are thermal and likely originate from deep volcanic heat, which was once prevalent in that area. One spring, located at the northern base of the hill where Claremont is situated, flows from volcanic peperino sitting atop granite. It has created an elevated mound of travertine, or white crystalline limestone, that is 240 feet long and, at its peak, 16 feet high and 12 feet wide. Another mineral-rich spring in the same region, found at Chaluzet near Pont Gibaud, rises in a gneiss area at the base of a distinct volcanic cone, over twenty miles from any limestone rock. Some of the deposits formed by this spring have an oolitic texture.

Valley of the Elsa.—If we pass from the volcanic district of France to that which skirts the Apennines in the Italian peninsula, we meet with innumerable springs which have precipitated so much calcareous matter, that the whole ground in some parts of Tuscany is coated over with tufa and travertin, and sounds hollow beneath the foot.

Valley of the Elsa.—If we move from the volcanic region of France to the area along the Apennines in Italy, we encounter countless springs that have deposited so much limestone that in some places in Tuscany, the ground is covered with tufa and travertine, and it sounds hollow when stepped on.

In other places in the same country, compact rocks are seen descending the slanting sides of hills, very much in the manner of lava currents, except that they are of a white color and terminate abruptly when they reach the course of a river. These consist of a calcareous precipitate from springs, some of which are still flowing, while others have disappeared 240 or changed their position. Such masses are frequent on the slope of the hills which bound the valley of the Elsa, one of the tributaries of the Arno, which flows near Colle, through a valley several hundred feet deep, shaped out of a lacustrine formation, containing fossil shells of existing species. I observed here that the travertin was unconformable to the lacustrine beds, its inclination according with the slope of the sides of the valley. One of the finest examples which I saw was at the Molino delle Caldane, near Colle. The Senà, and several other small rivulets which feed the Elsa, have the property of encrusting wood and herbs with calcareous stone. In the bed of the Elsa itself, aquatic plants, such as Charæ, which absorb large quantities of carbonate of lime, are very abundant.

In other parts of the same country, compact rocks can be seen sliding down the slanted sides of hills, quite like lava flows, except they’re white and stop abruptly when they reach a riverbed. These consist of a calcareous deposit from springs, some of which are still active, while others have dried up or shifted locations. 240 Such formations are common on the slopes of the hills that frame the valley of the Elsa, one of the tributaries of the Arno, which flows near Colle through a valley several hundred feet deep, formed from a lakebed and filled with fossil shells of living species. I noticed that the travertine didn’t align with the lakebed layers, its angle matching the slope of the valley sides. One of the best examples I saw was at the Molino delle Caldane, near Colle. The Senà and several other small streams that feed into the Elsa have the ability to coat wood and plants with calcareous stone. In the Elsa's riverbed itself, aquatic plants like Charæ, which absorb large amounts of calcium carbonate, are very common.

Fig. 21.Section of travertin, San Vignone.

Section of travertin, San Vignone.

Section of travertine, San Vignone.

Baths of San Vignone.—Those persons who have merely seen the action of petrifying waters in England, will not easily form an adequate conception of the scale on which the same process is exhibited in those regions which lie nearer to the active centres of volcanic disturbance. One of the most striking examples of the rapid precipitation of carbonate of lime from thermal waters, occurs in the hill of San Vignone in Tuscany, at a short distance from Radicofani, and only a few hundred yards from the high road between Sienna and Rome. The spring issues from near the summit of a rocky hill, about 100 feet in height. The top of the hill stretches in a gently inclined platform to the foot of Mount Amiata, a lofty eminence, which consists in great part of volcanic products. The fundamental rock, from which the spring issues, is a black slate, with serpentine (b b, fig. 21), belonging to the older Apennine formation. The water is hot, has a strong taste, and, when not in very small quantity, is of a bright green color. So rapid is the deposition near the source, that in the bottom of a conduit-pipe for carrying off the water to the baths, and which is inclined at an angle of 30°, half a foot of solid travertin is formed every year. A more compact rock is produced where the water flows slowly; and the precipitation in winter, when there is least evaporation, is said to be more solid, but less in quantity by one-fourth, than in summer. The rock is generally white; some parts of it are compact, and ring to the hammer; others are cellular, 241 and with such cavities as are seen in the carious part of bone or the siliceous millstone of the Paris basin. A portion of it also below the village of San Vignone consists of incrustations of long vegetable tubes, and may be called tufa. Sometimes the travertin assumes precisely the botryoidal and mammillary forms, common to similar deposits in Auvergne, of a much older date; and, like them, it often scales off in thin, slightly undulating layers.

Baths of San Vignone.—People who have only seen the effects of mineral springs in England will struggle to truly grasp the scale of the same process in areas closer to volcanoes. One of the most impressive examples of the quick buildup of calcium carbonate from hot springs is found on the hill of San Vignone in Tuscany, just a short distance from Radicofani and only a few hundred yards from the main road between Sienna and Rome. The spring comes from near the top of a rocky hill about 100 feet high. The top of the hill slopes gently down to the base of Mount Amiata, a tall peak primarily made of volcanic material. The underlying rock where the spring originates is black slate with serpentine (b b, fig. 21), part of the older Apennine formation. The water is hot, tastes strong, and when there’s enough of it, it has a bright green color. The buildup near the source is so rapid that in a drainage pipe angled at 30°, half a foot of solid travertine forms every year. A denser rock forms where the water flows more slowly, and during winter, when evaporation is at its lowest, the buildup is said to be more solid but amounts to a quarter less than in summer. The rock is generally white; some areas are solid and ring when struck, while others are cellular, with cavities similar to those found in decayed bone or the siliceous millstone from the Paris basin. A section of it below the village of San Vignone consists of layers made from long plant tubes, which can be referred to as tufa. Occasionally, the travertine takes on the characteristic botryoidal and mammillary shapes commonly seen in much older deposits in Auvergne, and like those, it often peels off in thin, slightly wavy layers.

A large mass of travertin (c, fig. 21) descends the hill from the point where the spring issues, and reaches to the distance of about half a mile east of San Vignone. The beds take the slope of the hill at about an angle of 6°, and the planes of stratification are perfectly parallel. One stratum, composed of many layers, is of a compact nature, and fifteen feet thick; it serves as an excellent building stone, and a mass of fifteen feet in length was, in 1828, cut out for the new bridge over the Orcia. Another branch of it (a, fig. 21) descends to the west, for 250 feet in length, of varying thickness, but sometimes 200 feet deep; it is then cut off by the small river Orcia, as some glaciers in Switzerland descend into a valley till their progress is suddenly arrested by a transverse stream of water.

A large mass of travertine (c, fig. 21) flows down the hill from where the spring emerges, extending about half a mile east of San Vignone. The layers follow the hill's slope at an angle of about 6°, and the layers are perfectly parallel. One layer, made up of many sections, is dense and fifteen feet thick; it is great for building stone, and a block measuring fifteen feet long was cut in 1828 for the new bridge over the Orcia. Another section of it (a, fig. 21) extends to the west for 250 feet in length, varying in thickness, but sometimes reaching 200 feet deep; it is then interrupted by the small river Orcia, similar to how some glaciers in Switzerland descend into a valley until they are suddenly stopped by a cross-stream of water.

The abrupt termination of the mass of rock at the river, where its thickness is undiminished, clearly shows that it would proceed much farther if not arrested by the stream, over which it impends slightly. But it cannot encroach upon the channel of the Orcia, being constantly undermined, so that its solid fragments are seen strewed amongst the alluvial gravel. However enormous, therefore, the mass of solid rock may appear which has been given out by this single spring, we may feel assured that it is insignificant in volume when compared to that which has been carried to the sea since the time when it began to flow. What may have been the length of that period of time we have no data for conjecturing. In quarrying the travertin, Roman tiles have been sometimes found at the depth of five or six feet.

The sudden end of the rock mass at the river, where it remains thick and unchanged, clearly indicates that it would extend much further if it weren't for the stream that slightly hangs over it. However, it cannot invade the channel of the Orcia, as it is constantly being eroded, leaving its solid pieces scattered among the river gravel. Therefore, no matter how massive the solid rock from this single spring appears, we can be sure that its volume is minor compared to what has been washed out to sea since it started flowing. We have no way to guess how long that period of time has been. While quarrying the travertine, Roman tiles have sometimes been discovered at depths of five or six feet.

Baths of San Filippo.—On another hill, not many miles from that last mentioned, and also connected with Mount Amiata, the summit of which is about three miles distant, are the celebrated baths of San Filippo. The subjacent rocks consist of alternations of black slate, limestone, and serpentine. There are three warm springs containing carbonate and sulphate of lime, and sulphate of magnesia. The water which supplies the baths falls into a pond, where it has been known to deposit a solid mass thirty feet thick in about twenty years.315 A manufactory of medallions in basso-relievo is carried on at these baths. The water is conducted by canals into several pits, in which it deposits travertin and crystals of sulphate of lime. After being thus freed from its grosser parts, it is conveyed by a tube to the summit of a small chamber, and made to fall through a space of ten or twelve feet. The current is broken in its descent by numerous crossed sticks, by which the 242 spray is dispersed around upon certain moulds, which are rubbed lightly over with a solution of soap, and a deposition of solid matter like marble is the result, yielding a beautiful cast of the figures formed in the mould. The geologist may derive from these experiments considerable light, in regard to the high slope of the strata at which some semi-crystalline precipitations can be formed; for some of the moulds are disposed almost perpendicularly, yet the deposition is nearly equal in all parts.

Baths of San Filippo.—On another hill, not far from the last one mentioned, and also linked to Mount Amiata, which is about three miles away, are the famous baths of San Filippo. The underlying rocks consist of layers of black slate, limestone, and serpentine. There are three warm springs that contain carbonate and sulfate of lime, and sulfate of magnesium. The water that supplies the baths flows into a pond, where it has been known to create a solid mass thirty feet thick in about twenty years.315 A factory producing medallions in basso-relievo operates at these baths. The water is channeled through canals into several pits, where it deposits travertine and crystals of sulfate of lime. Once it has been filtered of its coarser materials, it is transported via a tube to the top of a small chamber and allowed to fall through a distance of ten or twelve feet. The flow is broken on its way down by several crossed sticks, which disperse the spray onto certain molds, lightly coated with a soap solution, resulting in a solid matter resembling marble, creating beautiful casts of the figures formed in the mold. Geologists may gain valuable insights from these experiments regarding the steep slope of the strata at which some semi-crystalline deposits can form; for some molds are positioned almost vertically, yet the deposition is nearly uniform throughout.

A hard stratum of stone, about a foot in thickness, is obtained from the waters of San Filippo in four months; and, as the springs are powerful, and almost uniform in the quantity given out, we are at no loss to comprehend the magnitude of the mass which descends the hill, which is a mile and a quarter in length and the third of a mile in breadth, in some places attaining a thickness of 250 feet at least. To what length it might have reached it is impossible to conjecture, as it is cut off, like the travertin of San Vignone, by a small stream, where it terminates abruptly. The remainder of the matter held in solution is carried on probably to the sea.

A solid layer of stone, about a foot thick, is sourced from the waters of San Filippo in four months; and since the springs are strong and almost consistent in the amount they produce, we can easily understand the vastness of the mass that flows down the hill, which is a mile and a quarter long and a third of a mile wide, in some areas reaching a thickness of at least 250 feet. It's impossible to guess how far it might have extended, as it is cut off, like the travertine of San Vignone, by a small stream, where it ends abruptly. The remaining dissolved material is likely carried on to the sea.

Spheroidal structure in travertin.—But what renders this recent limestone of peculiar interest to the geologist, is the spheroidal form which it assumes, analogous to that of the cascade of Tivoli, afterwards to be described. (See fig. 22, p. 244.) The lamination of some of the concentric masses is so minute that sixty may be counted in the thickness of an inch, yet, notwithstanding these marks of gradual and successive deposition, sections are sometimes exhibited of what might seem to be perfect spheres. This tendency to a mammillary and globular structure arises from the facility with which the calcareous matter is precipitated in nearly equal quantities on all sides of any fragment of shell or wood or any inequality of the surface over which the mineral water flows, the form of the nucleus being readily transmitted through any number of successive envelopes. But these masses can never be perfect spheres, although they often appear such when a transverse section is made in any line not in the direction of the point of attachment. There are, indeed, occasionally seen small oolitic and pisolitic grains, of which the form is globular; for the nucleus, having been for a time in motion in the water, has received fresh accessions of matter on all sides.

Spheroidal structure in travertine.—What makes this recent limestone particularly interesting to geologists is its spheroidal shape, similar to that of the cascade at Tivoli, which will be described later. (See fig. 22, p. 244.) The layering of some of the concentric masses is so fine that you can count sixty layers in the thickness of an inch. Yet, despite these signs of gradual and successive deposition, there are times when sections show what looks like perfect spheres. This tendency toward a rounded and globular structure comes from the way calcareous matter is deposited evenly on all sides of any shell, wood fragment, or uneven surface over which the mineral water flows, with the shape of the nucleus easily passing through multiple layers. However, these masses can never be perfect spheres, even though they often look that way when a cross-section is taken anywhere other than in the direction of the point of attachment. There are, in fact, small oolitic and pisolitic grains that are shaped like little globes, as the nucleus has been in motion in the water for a time and has collected new material uniformly around it.

In the same manner I have seen, on the vertical walls of large steam-boilers, the heads of nails or rivets covered by a series of enveloping crusts of calcareous matter, usually sulphate of lime; so that a concretionary nodule is formed, preserving a nearly globular shape, when increased to a mass several inches in diameter. In these, as in many travertins, there is often a combination of the concentric and radiated structure.

In the same way, I've observed that on the vertical walls of large steam boilers, the heads of nails or rivets are covered by layers of lime-based deposits, usually gypsum. This results in the formation of a lump that retains a nearly spherical shape as it grows to several inches in diameter. In these formations, as in many travertines, there’s often a mix of concentric and radiating patterns.

Campagna di Roma.—The country around Rome, like many parts of the Tuscan States already referred to, has been at some former period the site of numerous volcanic eruptions; and the springs are still copiously impregnated with lime, carbonic acid, and sulphuretted hydrogen. 243 A hot spring was discovered about 1827, near Civita Vecchia, by Signor Riccioli, which deposits alternate beds of a yellowish travertin, and a white granular rock, not distinguishable, in hand specimens, either in grain, color, or composition, from statuary marble. There is a passage between this and ordinary travertin. The mass accumulated near the spring is in some places about six feet thick.

Campagna di Roma.—The area around Rome, like many parts of the Tuscan States mentioned earlier, was once the site of several volcanic eruptions; and the springs are still heavily infused with lime, carbon dioxide, and hydrogen sulfide. 243 A hot spring was discovered around 1827, near Civita Vecchia, by Signor Riccioli, which leaves behind layers of a yellowish travertine and a white granular rock, which cannot be distinguished, in hand samples, either in grain, color, or composition, from statuary marble. There is a connection between this and regular travertine. The mass that has built up near the spring is, in some places, about six feet thick.

Lake of the Solfatara.—In the Campagna, between Rome and Tivoli, is the Lake of the Solfatara, called also Lago di Zolfo (lacus albula), into which flows continually a stream of tepid water from a smaller lake, situated a few yards above it. The water is a saturated solution of carbonic acid gas, which escapes from it in such quantities in some parts of its surface, that it has the appearance of being actually in ebullition. "I have found by experiment," says Sir Humphry Davy, "that the water taken from the most tranquil part of the lake, even after being agitated and exposed to the air, contained in solution more than its own volume of carbonic acid gas, with a very small quantity of sulphuretted hydrogen. Its high temperature, which is pretty constant at 80° of Fahr., and the quantity of carbonic acid that it contains, render it peculiarly fitted to afford nourishment to vegetable life. The banks of travertin are everywhere covered with reeds, lichen, confervæ, and various kinds of aquatic vegetables; and at the same time that the process of vegetable life is going on, the crystallizations of the calcareous matter, which is everywhere deposited, in consequence of the escape of carbonic acid, likewise proceed. There is, I believe, no place in the world where there is a more striking example of the opposition or contrast of the laws of animate and inanimate nature, of the forces of inorganic chemical affinity, and those of the powers of life."316

Lake of the Solfatara.—In the Campagna, between Rome and Tivoli, is the Lake of the Solfatara, also known as Lago di Zolfo (lacus albula), into which a stream of warm water constantly flows from a smaller lake located just a few yards above it. The water is a saturated solution of carbonic acid gas, which escapes in such large quantities in some areas of its surface that it looks like it's actually boiling. "I have found by experiment," says Sir Humphry Davy, "that the water taken from the calmest part of the lake, even after being stirred and exposed to the air, contained in solution more than its own volume of carbonic acid gas, with a very small amount of hydrogen sulfide. Its high temperature, which is fairly constant at 80° Fahrenheit, and the significant amount of carbonic acid it contains, make it particularly suitable for supporting plant life. The banks made of travertine are completely covered with reeds, lichen, algae, and various types of aquatic plants; and while the process of plant life is happening, the crystallization of the calcareous matter, deposited everywhere due to the release of carbonic acid, also continues. I believe there is no place in the world that provides a more striking example of the contrast between the laws of living and non-living nature, the forces of inorganic chemical attraction, and the powers of life."316

The same observer informs us that he fixed a stick in a mass of travertin covered by the water in the month of May, and in April following he had some difficulty in breaking, with a sharp-pointed hammer, the mass which adhered to the stick, and which was several inches in thickness. The upper part was a mixture of light tufa and the leaves of confervæ; below this was a darker and more solid travertin, containing black and decomposed masses of confervæ; in the inferior part the travertin was more solid, and of a gray color, but with cavities probably produced by the decomposition of vegetable matter.317

The same observer tells us that he stuck a stick into a mass of travertine covered by water in May, and in the following April, he had some trouble breaking the mass that was stuck to the stick, which was several inches thick. The top layer was a mix of light tufa and leaves of algae; beneath that was a darker, denser travertine that contained black and decomposed algae. In the lower section, the travertine was even denser and gray, but it had cavities likely caused by the breakdown of plant matter.317

The stream which flows out of this lake fills a canal about nine feet broad and four deep, and is conspicuous in the landscape by a line of vapor which rises from it. It deposits calcareous tufa in this channel, and the Tiber probably receives from it, as well as from numerous other streams, much carbonate of lime in solution, which may contribute to the rapid growth of its delta. A large proportion of the most splendid edifices of ancient and modern Rome are built of travertin, derived from the quarries of Ponte Lucano, where there has evidently been a lake at a remote period, on the same plain as that already described.

The stream flowing out of this lake fills a canal about nine feet wide and four feet deep, and you can easily spot it in the landscape by the mist rising from it. It leaves behind calcareous tufa in this channel, and the Tiber likely gets a lot of dissolved calcium carbonate from it as well as from many other streams, which may help its delta grow quickly. Many of the most stunning buildings in both ancient and modern Rome are made from travertine, sourced from the quarries of Ponte Lucano, where there was clearly a lake long ago, in the same plain described earlier.

Fig. 22.Section of spheroidal concretionary Travertin under the Cascade of Tivoli.

Section of spheroidal concretionary Travertin under the Cascade of Tivoli.

Section of spherical concretions of Travertine under the Cascade of Tivoli.

244 Travertin of Tivoli.—In the same neighborhood the calcareous waters of the Anio incrust the reeds which grow on its banks, and the foam of the cataract of Tivoli forms beautiful pendant stalactites. On the sides of the deep chasm into which the cascade throws itself, there is seen an extraordinary accumulation of horizontal beds of tufa and travertin, from four to five hundred feet in thickness. The section immediately under the temples of Vesta and the Sibyl, displays, in a precipice about four hundred feet high, some spheroids which are from six to eight feet in diameter, each concentric layer being about the eighth of an inch in thickness. The preceding diagram exhibits about fourteen feet of this immense mass, as seen in the path cut out of the rock in descending from the temple of Vesta to the Grotto di Nettuno. I have not attempted to express in this drawing the innumerable thin layers of which these magnificent spheroids are composed, but the lines given mark some of the natural divisions into which they are separated by minute variations in the size or color of the laminæ. The undulations 245 also are much smaller in proportion to the whole circumference than in the drawing. The beds (a a) are of hard travertin and soft tufa; below them is a pisolite (b), the globules being of different sizes: underneath this appears a mass of concretionary travertin (c c), some of the spheroids being of the above-mentioned extraordinary size. In some places (as at d) there is a mass of amorphous limestone, or tufa, surrounded by concentric layers. At the bottom is another bed of pisolite (b), in which the small nodules are about the size and shape of beans, and some of them of filberts, intermixed with some smaller oolitic grains. In the tufaceous strata, wood is seen converted into a light tufa.

244 Travertin of Tivoli.—In the same area, the calcareous waters of the Anio coat the reeds along its banks, and the foam from the waterfall in Tivoli creates beautiful hanging stalactites. The walls of the deep chasm where the waterfall falls show an incredible buildup of horizontal layers of tufa and travertine, ranging from four to five hundred feet thick. The section right below the temples of Vesta and the Sibyl shows, in a cliff about four hundred feet high, some rounded formations that are between six to eight feet in diameter, with each concentric layer being roughly one-eighth of an inch thick. The earlier diagram illustrates about fourteen feet of this vast mass, as seen in the path carved from the rock when descending from the temple of Vesta to the Grotto di Nettuno. I haven't tried to depict in this drawing the countless thin layers making up these stunning spheroids, but the marked lines indicate some of the natural divisions created by slight variations in size or color of the layers. The undulations 245 are also much smaller compared to the entire circumference than shown in the drawing. The layers (a a) consist of hard travertine and soft tufa; underneath them is a pisolite (b), with globules of varying sizes: below this is a mass of concretionary travertine (c c), with some of the spheroids being the previously mentioned extraordinary size. In some spots (like at d), there's a mass of amorphous limestone or tufa surrounded by concentric layers. At the bottom is another layer of pisolite (b), where the small nodules are about the size and shape of beans, with some resembling filberts, mixed in with smaller oolitic grains. In the tufa layers, wood can be seen transformed into a light tufa.

There can be little doubt that the whole of this deposit was formed in an extensive lake which existed when the external configuration of this country varied greatly from that now observed. The Anio throws itself into a ravine excavated in the ancient travertin, and its waters give rise to masses of calcareous stone, scarcely if at all distinguishable from the older rock. I was shown, in 1828, in the upper part of the travertin, the hollow left by a cart-wheel, in which the outer circle and the spokes had been decomposed, and the spaces which they filled left void. It seemed to me at the time impossible to explain the position of this mould without supposing that the wheel was imbedded before the lake was drained; but Sir R. Murchison suggests that it may have been washed down by a flood into the gorge in modern times, and then incrusted with calcareous tufa in the same manner as the wooden beam of the church of St. Lucia was swept down in 1826, and stuck fast in the Grotto of the Syren, where it still remains, and will eventually be quite imbedded in travertin.

There’s no doubt that this entire deposit was formed in a large lake that existed when the landscape in this area looked very different from what we see today. The Anio River flows into a ravine carved into the ancient travertine, and its waters create masses of limestone that are hardly distinguishable from the older rock. In 1828, I was shown the imprint of a cart-wheel in the upper part of the travertine, where the outer circle and spokes had deteriorated, leaving empty spaces. At that time, it seemed impossible to explain the position of this mold without thinking that the wheel got stuck there before the lake was drained. However, Sir R. Murchison suggests that it might have been washed down by a flood into the gorge in more recent times and then covered with calcareous tufa, similar to how a wooden beam from the church of St. Lucia was swept away in 1826 and lodged in the Grotto of the Syren, where it still remains and will eventually be completely embedded in travertine.

I have already endeavored to explain (p. 241), when speaking of the travertin of San Filippo, how the spheroidal masses represented in figure 22 may have been formed.

I have already tried to explain (p. 241), when discussing the travertine of San Filippo, how the spherical masses shown in figure 22 might have formed.

Sulphureous and gypseus springs.—The quantity of other mineral ingredients wherewith springs in general are impregnated, is insignificant in comparison to lime, and this earth is most frequently combined with carbonic acid. But as sulphuric acid, and sulphuretted hydrogen are very frequently supplied by springs, gypsum may, perhaps, be deposited largely in certain seas and lakes. Among other gypseous precipitates at present known on the land, I may mention those of Baden, near Vienna, which feed the public bath. Some of these supply singly from 600 to 1000 cubic feet of water per hour, and deposit a fine powder, composed of a mixture of sulphate of lime with sulphur and muriate of lime.318 The thermal waters of Aix, in Savoy, in passing through strata of Jurassic limestone, turn them into gypsum or sulphate of lime. In the Andes, at the Puenta del Inca, Lieutenant Brand found a thermal spring at the temperature of 91° Fahr., containing a large proportion of gypsum with carbonate of lime and other ingredients. 246 319 Many of the mineral springs of Iceland, says Mr. R. Bunsen, deposit gypsum.320 and sulphureous acid gas escapes plentifully from them as from the volcanoes of the same island. It may, indeed, be laid down as a general rule, that the mineral substances dissolved in hot springs agree very closely with those which are disengaged in a gaseous form from the craters of active volcanoes.

Sulfur and gypsum springs.—The amount of other mineral substances found in springs is minimal compared to limestone, which is usually combined with carbonic acid. However, because sulfuric acid and hydrogen sulfide are often present in springs, gypsum may be deposited extensively in certain seas and lakes. Among the known gypsum deposits on land, I can mention those in Baden, near Vienna, which feed the public bath. Some of these produce between 600 to 1,000 cubic feet of water per hour and leave behind a fine powder made of a mix of gypsum (sulfate of lime), sulfur, and calcium chloride.318 The thermal waters of Aix in Savoy, as they flow through Jurassic limestone layers, convert them into gypsum or sulfate of lime. In the Andes, at Puenta del Inca, Lieutenant Brand discovered a thermal spring at a temperature of 91°F, containing a large amount of gypsum along with calcium carbonate and other minerals. 246 319 Many of Iceland’s mineral springs, according to Mr. R. Bunsen, also deposit gypsum.320 Additionally, sulfuric acid gas escapes abundantly from them, similar to the volcanoes on the island. It can be generally stated that the mineral substances dissolved in hot springs closely resemble those released in gaseous form from the craters of active volcanoes.

Siliceous springs.—Azores.—In order that water should hold a very large quantity of silica in solution, it seems necessary that it should be raised to a high temperature.321 The hot springs of the Valle das Fernas, in the island of St. Michael, rising through volcanic rocks, precipitate vast quantities of siliceous sinter. Around the circular basin of the largest spring, which is between twenty and thirty feet in diameter, alternate layers are seen of a coarser variety of sinter mixed with clay, including grass, ferns, and reeds, in different states of petrifaction. In some instances, alumina, which is likewise deposited from the hot waters, is the mineralizing material. Branches of the same ferns which now flourish in the island are found completely petrified, preserving the same appearance as when vegetating, except that they acquire an ash-gray color. Fragments of wood, and one entire bed from three to five feet in depth, composed of reeds now common in the island, have become completely mineralized.

Siliceous springs.—Azores.—For water to hold a significant amount of silica in solution, it appears that it needs to be heated to a high temperature.321 The hot springs in the Valle das Fernas on the island of St. Michael, emerging through volcanic rocks, deposit large amounts of siliceous sinter. Around the circular basin of the biggest spring, which is about twenty to thirty feet across, you can see alternating layers of a coarser type of sinter mixed with clay, including grass, ferns, and reeds in various stages of fossilization. In some cases, alumina, which is also deposited from the hot water, is the mineralizing substance. Branches of the same ferns that thrive on the island are found fully petrified, maintaining their appearance as if they were still alive, except they turn an ash-gray color. Pieces of wood, along with one entire layer that is three to five feet deep made up of reeds common to the island, have become fully mineralized.

The most abundant variety of siliceous sinter occurs in layers, from a quarter to half an inch in thickness, accumulated on each other often to the height of a foot and upwards, and constituting parallel, and for the most part horizontal, strata many yards in extent. This sinter has often a beautiful semi-opalescent lustre. A recent breccia is also in the act of forming, composed of obsidian, pumice, and scoriæ, cemented by siliceous sinter.322

The most abundant type of siliceous sinter is found in layers, ranging from a quarter to half an inch thick, stacked on top of each other often up to a foot high or more, creating parallel, mostly horizontal layers that can extend for many yards. This sinter often has a beautiful semi-opalescent shine. A new breccia is also forming, made up of obsidian, pumice, and scoria, bonded together by siliceous sinter.322

Geysers of Iceland.—But the hot springs in various parts of Iceland, particularly the celebrated geysers, afford the most remarkable example of the deposition of silex.323 The circular reservoirs into which the geysers fall, are lined in the interior with a variety of opal, and round the edges with sinter. The plants incrusted with the latter substance have much the same appearance as those incrusted with calcareous tufa in our own country. They consist of various grasses, the horse-tail (Equisetum), and leaves of the birch-tree, which are the most common of all, though no trees of this species now exist in the surrounding country. The petrified stems also of the birch occur in a state much resembling agatized wood.324

Geysers of Iceland.—The hot springs in different parts of Iceland, especially the famous geysers, provide the most extraordinary example of the deposition of silica.323 The circular basins that the geysers feed are lined inside with various types of opal, and around the edges with sinter. The plants coated with this substance look very similar to those coated with calcareous tufa in our own country. They include different types of grasses, the horse-tail (Equisetum), and leaves from the birch tree, which are the most common, even though no birch trees currently grow in the nearby area. The fossilized stems of the birch also appear in a form that closely resembles agatized wood.324

By analysis of the water, Mr. Faraday has ascertained that the solution of the silex is promoted by the presence of the alkali, soda. He suggests that the deposition of silica in an insoluble state takes place partly because the water when cooled by exposure to the air is unable 247 to retain as much silica as when it issues from the earth at a temperature of 180° or 190° Fahr.; and partly because the evaporation of the water decomposes the compound of silica and soda which previously existed. This last change is probably hastened by the carbonic acid of the atmosphere uniting with the soda. The alkali, when disunited from the silica, would readily be dissolved in and removed by running water.325

By analyzing the water, Mr. Faraday has determined that the presence of the alkali, soda, helps the solution of silex. He proposes that silica deposits in an insoluble form happen partly because the water, when cooled by exposure to air, can't hold as much silica as when it comes from the earth at a temperature of 180° or 190° Fahrenheit; and partly because the evaporation of the water breaks down the silica and soda compound that existed before. This last change is likely sped up by carbonic acid in the atmosphere combining with the soda. Once the alkali is separated from the silica, it would easily dissolve in and be carried away by running water.247325

Mineral waters, even when charged with a small proportion of silica, as those of Ischia, may supply certain species of corals, sponges, and infusoria, with matter for their siliceous secretions; but there is little doubt that rivers obtain silex in solution from another and far more general source, namely, the decomposition of felspar. When this mineral, which is so abundant an ingredient in the hypogene and trappean rocks, has disintegrated, it is found that the residue, called porcelain clay, contains a small proportion only of the silica which existed in the original felspar, the other part having been dissolved and removed by water.326

Mineral waters, even when they contain a small amount of silica, like those from Ischia, can provide certain types of corals, sponges, and tiny aquatic organisms with materials for their silica-based secretions. However, it's clear that rivers get silica in solution from another, much more common source: the breakdown of feldspar. When this mineral, which is a major component of deep and volcanic rocks, breaks down, the leftover material, known as porcelain clay, has only a small amount of the silica that was in the original feldspar; the rest has been dissolved and washed away by water.326

Ferruginous springs.—The waters of almost all springs contain some iron in solution; and it is a fact familiar to all, that many of them are so copiously impregnated with this metal, as to stain the rocks or herbage through which they pass, and to bind together sand and gravel into solid masses. We may naturally, then, conclude that this iron, which is constantly conveyed from the interior of the earth into lakes and seas, and which does not escape again from them into the atmosphere by evaporation, must act as a coloring and cementing principle in the subaqueous deposits now in progress. Geologists are aware that many ancient sandstones and conglomerates are bound together or colored by iron.

Ferruginous springs.—The waters of nearly all springs contain some iron dissolved in them; and it's well-known that many of them have such a high concentration of this metal that they stain the rocks or vegetation they flow through, and they can form solid masses of sand and gravel. Therefore, we can reasonably conclude that this iron, which is continually moved from the earth's interior into lakes and seas, and doesn't return to the atmosphere through evaporation, must play a role as a coloring and binding agent in the underwater deposits that are currently forming. Geologists know that many ancient sandstones and conglomerates are either held together or colored by iron.

Brine springs.—So great is the quantity of muriate of soda in some springs, that they yield one-fourth of their weight in salt. They are rarely, however, so saturated, and generally contain, intermixed with salt, carbonate and sulphate of lime, magnesia, and other mineral ingredients. The brine springs of Cheshire are the richest in our country; those of Northwich being almost saturated. Those of Barton also, in Lancashire, and Droitwich in Worcestershire, are extremely rich.327 They are known to have flowed for more than 1000 years, and the quantity of salt which they have carried into the Severn and Mersey must be enormous. These brine springs rise up through strata of sandstone and red marl, which contain large beds of rock salt. The origin of the brine, therefore, may be derived in this and many other instances from beds of fossil salt; but as muriate of soda is one of the products of volcanic emanations and of springs in volcanic regions, the original source of salt may be as deep seated as that of lava.

Brine springs.—Some springs have such a high amount of sodium chloride that they produce one-fourth of their weight in salt. However, they are rarely that concentrated and usually contain, along with salt, carbonate and sulfate of lime, magnesium, and other mineral components. The brine springs in Cheshire are the richest in our country; those in Northwich are nearly saturated. The springs in Barton, Lancashire, and Droitwich, Worcestershire, are also extremely rich.327 They are known to have been active for over 1000 years, and the amount of salt they have carried into the Severn and Mersey rivers must be enormous. These brine springs rise through layers of sandstone and red marl, which have large deposits of rock salt. Therefore, the origin of the brine may come from these fossil salt beds; however, since sodium chloride is also a product of volcanic emissions and springs in volcanic areas, the original source of the salt could be as deep as that of lava.

Many springs in Sicily contain muriate of soda, and the "fiume salso," 248 in particular, is impregnated with so large a quantity, that cattle refuse to drink of it. A hot spring, rising through granite, at Saint Nectaire, in Auvergne, may be mentioned as one of many, containing a large proportion of muriate of soda, together with magnesia and other ingredients.328

Many springs in Sicily have sodium chloride, and the "fiume salso," 248 especially, has such a high concentration that cattle won’t drink from it. A hot spring in Saint Nectaire, Auvergne, which rises through granite, is another example, containing a significant amount of sodium chloride, along with magnesium and other components.328

Carbonated springs.—Auvergne.—Carbonic acid gas is very plentifully disengaged from springs in almost all countries, but particularly near active or extinct volcanoes. This elastic fluid has the property of decomposing many of the hardest rocks with which it comes in contact, particularly that numerous class in whose composition felspar is an ingredient. It renders the oxide of iron soluble in water, and contributes, as was before stated, to the solution of calcareous matter. In volcanic districts these gaseous emanations are not confined to springs, but rise up in the state of pure gas from the soil in various places. The Grotto del Cane, near Naples, affords an example, and prodigious quantities are now annually disengaged from every part of the Limagne d'Auvergne, where it appears to have been developed in equal quantity from time immemorial. As the acid is invisible, it is not observed, except an excavation be made, wherein it immediately accumulates, so that it will extinguish a candle. There are some springs in this district, where the water is seen bubbling and boiling up with much noise, in consequence of the abundant disengagement of this gas. In the environs of Pont-Gibaud, not far from Clermont, a rock belonging to the gneiss formation, in which lead-mines are worked, has been found to be quite saturated with carbonic acid gas, which is constantly disengaged. The carbonates of iron, lime, and manganese are so dissolved, that the rock is rendered soft, and the quartz alone remains unattacked.329 Not far off is the small volcanic cone of Chaluzet, which once broke up through the gneiss, and sent forth a lava stream.

Carbonated springs.—Auvergne.—Carbon dioxide gas is released abundantly from springs in almost every country, especially near active or dormant volcanoes. This gas has the ability to break down many of the hardest rocks it comes into contact with, particularly those containing feldspar. It makes iron oxide soluble in water and, as mentioned before, helps dissolve calcareous matter. In volcanic regions, these gas emissions aren't just found in springs, but also rise as pure gas from the ground in various locations. The Grotto del Cane near Naples is one example, and huge amounts are now released every year from every part of the Limagne d'Auvergne, seemingly in equal measure for ages. Since the gas is invisible, it goes unnoticed unless there's a hole, where it quickly builds up and can extinguish a candle. There are some springs in this area where the water bubbles and boils noisily due to the large release of this gas. Near Pont-Gibaud, not far from Clermont, a rock formation consisting of gneiss, where lead mines are operated, has been found to be completely saturated with carbon dioxide gas, which is constantly being released. The carbonates of iron, lime, and manganese are so dissolved that the rock becomes soft, leaving only the quartz intact.329 Close by is the small volcanic cone of Chaluzet, which once erupted through the gneiss and unleashed a lava flow.

Supposed atmosphere of carbonic acid.—Prof. Bischoff in his history of volcanoes,330 has shown what enormous quantities of carbonic acid gas are exhaled in the vicinity of the extinct craters of the Rhine (in the neighborhood of the Laacher-see, for example, and the Eifel), and also in the mineral springs of Nassau and other countries, where there are no immediate traces of volcanic action. It would be easy to calculate in how short a period the solid carbon, thus emitted from the interior of the earth in an invisible form, would amount to a quantity as great as could be obtained from the trees of a large forest, and how many thousand years would be required to supply the materials of a dense seam of pure coal from the same source. Geologists who favor the doctrine of the former existence of an atmosphere highly charged with carbonic acid, at the period of the ancient coal-plants, have not sufficiently reflected on the continual disengagement of carbon, which is taking place in a gaseous form from springs, as also in a free state from the ground and from 249 volcanic craters into the air. We know that all plants are now engaged in secreting carbon, and many thousands of large trees are annually floated down by great rivers, and buried in their alluvial deposits; but before we can assume that the quantity of carbon which becomes permanently locked up in the earth by such agency will bring about an essential change in the chemical composition of the atmosphere, we must be sure that the trees annually buried contain more carbon than is given out from the interior of the earth in the same lapse of time. Every large area covered by a dense mass of peat, bears ample testimony to the fact, that several million tons of carbon have been taken from the air, by the powers of vegetable life, and stored up in the earth's crust, a large quantity of oxygen having been at the same time set free; but we cannot infer from these circumstances, that the constitution of the atmosphere has been materially deranged, until we have data for estimating the rate at which dead animal and vegetable substances are daily putrefying,—organic remains and various calcareous rocks decomposing, and volcanic regions emitting fresh volumes of carbonic acid gas. That the ancient carboniferous period was one of vast duration all geologists are agreed; instead, therefore, of supposing an excess of carbonic acid in the air at that epoch, for the support of a peculiar flora, we may imagine Time to have multiplied the quantity of carbon given out annually by mineral springs, volcanic craters, and other sources, until the component elements of any given number of coal-seams had been evolved from below, without any variation taking place in the constitution of the atmosphere. It has been too common, in reasoning on this question, to compute the loss of carbon by the volume of coal stored up in the ancient strata, and to take no account of the annual gain, by the restoration of carbonic acid to the atmosphere, through the machinery above alluded to.331

Supposed atmosphere of carbon dioxide.—Prof. Bischoff in his history of volcanoes,330 has shown the massive amounts of carbon dioxide released near the extinct craters of the Rhine (like around Laacher See and the Eifel), along with the mineral springs in Nassau and other regions, where there are no direct signs of volcanic activity. It would be straightforward to calculate how quickly the solid carbon released from the Earth's interior in an invisible form could match the amount obtained from the trees in a large forest, and how many thousands of years it would take to provide enough material for a dense seam of pure coal from the same source. Geologists who support the idea that there used to be a carbon dioxide-rich atmosphere during the time of ancient coal plants haven’t fully considered the ongoing release of carbon, which occurs in gaseous form from springs, as well as freely from the ground and volcanic craters into the air. We know that all plants are currently involved in absorbing carbon, and many thousands of large trees are carried down by rivers each year and buried in their sediment; however, before we can assume that the amount of carbon permanently stored in the Earth through this process causes a significant change in the chemical makeup of the atmosphere, we need to ensure that the carbon set aside annually in buried trees exceeds what is released from the Earth's interior over the same period. Every extensive area covered by a thick layer of peat provides clear evidence that several million tons of carbon have been extracted from the air by plants and stored in the Earth’s crust, while a large amount of oxygen has been liberated at the same time; but we cannot conclude from these facts that the atmosphere’s composition has been significantly altered until we have data to estimate how quickly dead animal and plant matter is decomposing daily—organic remains, various calcareous rocks breaking down, and volcanic areas releasing new volumes of carbon dioxide. All geologists agree that the ancient carboniferous period lasted a very long time; therefore, instead of assuming an excess of carbon dioxide in the air during that time, supporting a unique type of plant life, we might consider that Time has increased the amount of carbon released annually by mineral springs, volcanic craters, and other sources, until the elements that make up any coal seams were released from below, without any changes occurring in the atmosphere's composition. It has often been oversimplified in discussing this issue to calculate the loss of carbon solely by the amount of coal in ancient layers while ignoring the annual gain from the release of carbon dioxide back into the atmosphere through the processes mentioned above.331

Disintegrating effects of carbonic acid.—The disintegration of granite is a striking feature of large districts in Auvergne, especially in the neighborhood of Clermont. This decay was called by Dolomieu, "la maladie du granite;" and the rock may with propriety be said to have the rot, for it crumbles to pieces in the hand. The phenomenon may, without doubt, be ascribed to the continual disengagement of carbonic acid gas from numerous fissures.

Disintegrating effects of carbonic acid.—The breakdown of granite is a notable characteristic of vast areas in Auvergne, particularly around Clermont. This deterioration was referred to by Dolomieu as "la maladie du granite," and it is quite accurate to say that the rock has the rot, as it crumbles easily in your hand. This phenomenon can undoubtedly be attributed to the constant release of carbonic acid gas from numerous cracks.

In the plains of the Po, between Verona and Parma, especially at Villa Franca, south of Mantua, I observed great beds of alluvium, consisting chiefly of primary pebbles, percolated by spring-water, charged with carbonate of lime and carbonic acid in great abundance. They are for the most part incrusted with calc-sinter; and the rounded blocks of gneiss, which have all the outward appearance of solidity, have been so disintegrated by the carbonic acid as readily to fall to pieces.

In the plains of the Po, between Verona and Parma, especially at Villa Franca, south of Mantua, I noticed large deposits of alluvium made mostly of primary pebbles, filtered by spring water that was rich in calcium carbonate and carbonic acid. Most of them are coated with calc-sinter, and the rounded gneiss blocks, which look solid on the outside, have been so broken down by the carbonic acid that they easily fall apart.

The subtraction of many of the elements of rocks by the solvent power of carbonic acid, ascending both in a gaseous state and mixed with spring-water in the crevices of rocks, must be one of the most powerful 250 sources of those internal changes and rearrangements of particles so often observed in strata of every age. The calcareous matter, for example, of shells, is often entirely removed and replaced by carbonate of iron, pyrites, silex, or some other ingredient, such as mineral waters usually contain in solution. It rarely happens, except in limestone rocks, that the carbonic acid can dissolve all the constituent parts of the mass; and for this reason, probably, calcareous rocks are almost the only ones in which great caverns and long winding passages are found.

The removal of many elements from rocks by the solvent action of carbonic acid, rising both as a gas and mixed with spring water in the crevices of rocks, is likely one of the major sources of the internal changes and rearrangements of particles that we frequently see in strata of all ages. For instance, the calcareous material from shells is often completely taken away and replaced by iron carbonate, pyrite, silica, or other substances typically found dissolved in mineral water. It’s rare, except in limestone rocks, for carbonic acid to dissolve all the components of the mass; and this is probably why calcareous rocks are almost the only type that has significant caverns and lengthy twisting passages.

Petroleum springs.—Springs of which the waters contain a mixture of petroleum and the various minerals allied to it, as bitumen, naphtha, asphaltum, and pitch, are very numerous, and are, in many cases, undoubtedly connected with subterranean fires, which raise or sublime the more subtle parts of the bituminous matters contained in rocks. Many springs in the territory of Modena and Parma, in Italy, produce petroleum in abundance; but the most powerful, perhaps, yet known, are those on the Irawadi, in the Burman empire. In one locality there are said to be 520 wells, which yield annually 400,000 hogsheads of petroleum.332

Petroleum springs.—There are many springs that contain a mix of petroleum and various related minerals like bitumen, naphtha, asphaltum, and pitch. In many cases, these springs are definitely linked to underground fires that enhance or raise the more refined components of the bituminous materials found in rocks. Numerous springs in the regions of Modena and Parma in Italy produce a lot of petroleum; however, the most powerful ones known so far are located on the Irawadi in the Burman Empire. In one area, it's reported that there are 520 wells that produce 400,000 hogsheads of petroleum each year.332

Pitch lake of Trinidad.—Fluid bitumen is seen to ooze from the bottom of the sea, on both sides of the island of Trinidad, and to rise up to the surface of the water. Near Cape La Braye there is a vortex which, in stormy weather, according to Captain Mallet, gushes out, raising the water five or six feet, and covers the surface for a considerable space with petroleum, or tar; and the same author quotes Gumilla, as stating, in his "Description of the Orinoco," that about seventy years ago, a spot of land on the western coast of Trinidad, near half-way between the capital and an Indian village, sank suddenly, and was immediately replaced by a small lake of pitch, to the great terror of the inhabitants.333

Pitch lake of Trinidad.—Liquid bitumen is seen oozing from the bottom of the sea on both sides of Trinidad and rising to the surface of the water. Near Cape La Braye, there's a vortex that, during stormy weather, according to Captain Mallet, erupts, lifting the water five or six feet and covering a large area with petroleum or tar. The same author cites Gumilla, who mentions in his "Description of the Orinoco" that about seventy years ago, a piece of land on the western coast of Trinidad, halfway between the capital and an Indian village, suddenly sank, and was immediately replaced by a small lake of pitch, causing great panic among the locals.333

It is probable that the great pitch lake of Trinidad owes its origin to a similar cause; and Dr. Nugent has justly remarked, that in that district all the circumstances are now combined from which deposits of pitch may have originated. The Orinoco has for ages been rolling down great quantities of woody and vegetable bodies into the surrounding sea, where, by the influence of currents and eddies, they may be arrested and accumulated in particular places. The frequent occurrence of earthquakes and other indications of volcanic action in those parts lend countenance to the opinion, that these vegetable substances may have undergone, by the agency of subterranean fire, those transformations and chemical changes which produce petroleum; and this may, by the same causes, be forced up to the surface, where, by exposure to the air, it becomes inspissated, and forms the different varieties of pure and earthy pitch, or asphaltum, so abundant in the island.334

It’s likely that the great pitch lake of Trinidad was formed in a similar way, and Dr. Nugent has rightly pointed out that in that area, all the right conditions are now present for pitch deposits to have formed. The Orinoco River has been carrying large amounts of wood and plant material into the surrounding sea for ages, where they might get caught and built up in certain spots due to currents and eddies. The frequent earthquakes and other signs of volcanic activity in that region support the idea that these plant materials may have gone through transformations and chemical changes caused by underground heat, resulting in petroleum; and this may, for the same reasons, be pushed up to the surface, where exposure to air causes it to thicken and create the various types of pure and earthy pitch, or asphaltum, that are so plentiful on the island.334

251 It may be stated generally, that a large portion of the finer particles and the more crystalline substances, found in sedimentary rocks of different ages, are composed of the same elements as are now held in solution by springs, while the coarser materials bear an equally strong resemblance to the pebbles and sedimentary matter carried down by torrents and rivers. It should also be remembered, that it is not only during inundations, when the muddy sediment is apparent, that rivers are busy in conveying solid matter to the sea, but that even when their waters are perfectly transparent, they are annually bearing along vast masses of carbon, lime, and silica to the ocean.

251 It can be generally said that a large portion of the finer particles and more crystalline substances found in sedimentary rocks from various ages are made up of the same elements currently found in solution in springs. Meanwhile, the coarser materials closely resemble the pebbles and sediment that are carried away by torrents and rivers. It's also important to remember that rivers aren't only transporting solid matter to the sea during floods, when the muddy sediment is visible; even when their waters are completely clear, they are still annually carrying huge amounts of carbon, lime, and silica to the ocean.


CHAPTER XVII.

REPRODUCTIVE EFFECTS OF RIVERS.

Lake deltas—Growth of the delta of the Upper Rhine in the Lake of Geneva—Computation of the age of deltas—Recent deposits in Lake Superior—Deltas of inland seas—Course of the Po—Artificial embankments of the Po and Adige—Delta of the Po, and other rivers entering the Adriatic—Rapid conversion of that gulf into land—Mineral characters of the new deposits—Marine delta of the Rhone—Various proofs of its increase—Stony nature of its deposits—Coast of Asia Minor—Delta of the Nile.

Lake deltas—Development of the Upper Rhine delta in Lake Geneva—Calculating the age of deltas—Recent sediment in Lake Superior—Deltas of inland seas—Path of the Po—Man-made levees of the Po and Adige—Delta of the Po and other rivers flowing into the Adriatic—Quick transformation of that gulf into land—Mineral properties of the new deposits—Marine delta of the Rhône—Different evidence of its growth—Rocky composition of its deposits—Coast of Asia Minor—Delta of the Nile.

DELTAS IN LAKES.

I have already spoken in the 14th chapter of the action of running water, and of the denuding power of rivers, but we can only form a just conception of the excavating and removing force exerted by such bodies of water, when we have the advantage of examining the reproductive effects of the same agents: in other words, of beholding in a palpable form the aggregate amount of matter, which they have thrown down at certain points in their alluvial plains, or in the basins of lakes and seas. Yet it will appear, when we consider the action of currents, that the growth of deltas affords a very inadequate standard by which to measure the entire carrying power of running water, since a considerable portion of fluviatile sediment is swept far out to sea.

I’ve already discussed in the 14th chapter the effects of flowing water and the erosion power of rivers, but we can only truly understand the digging and transporting force of these bodies of water when we examine the ways they contribute to new land. In other words, we need to see the visible results of the amount of material they've deposited at specific locations in their floodplains or in the basins of lakes and oceans. However, when we look at the flow of currents, we’ll find that the formation of deltas provides a limited way to assess the full transporting ability of flowing water, as a significant amount of river sediment is carried far out to sea.

Deltas may be divided into, first, those which are formed in lakes; secondly, those in island seas, where the tides are almost imperceptible; and, thirdly, those on the borders of the ocean. The most characteristic distinction between the lacustrine and marine deltas consists in the nature of the organic remains which become imbedded in their deposits; for, in the case of a lake, it is obvious that these must consist exclusively of such genera of animals as inhabit the land or the waters of a river or a lake; whereas, in the other case, there will be an admixture, and most frequently a predominance, of animals which inhabit salt water. In regard, however, to the distribution of inorganic 252 matter, the deposits of lakes and seas are formed under very analogous circumstances.

Deltas can be divided into three types: first, those formed in lakes; second, those in inland seas where the tides are barely noticeable; and third, those along the ocean's edge. The main difference between lacustrine (lake) and marine deltas lies in the types of organic remains found in their deposits. In a lake delta, these remains will only include animals that live on land or in the waters of a river or lake. In contrast, marine deltas will usually contain a mix of organisms, often with a greater presence of saltwater species. However, when it comes to the distribution of inorganic matter, the deposits in lakes and seas form under very similar conditions. 252

Lake of Geneva.—Lakes exemplify the first reproductive operations in which rivers are engaged when they convey the detritus of rocks and the ingredients of mineral springs from mountainous regions. The accession of new land at the mouth of the Rhone, at the upper end of the Lake of Geneva, or the Leman Lake, presents us with an example of a considerable thickness of strata which have accumulated since the historical era. This sheet of water is about thirty-seven miles long, and its breadth is from two to eight miles. The shape of the bottom is very irregular, the depth having been found by late measurements to vary from 20 to 160 fathoms.335 The Rhone, where it enters at the upper end, is turbid and discolored; but its waters, where it issues at the town of Geneva, are beautifully clear and transparent. An ancient town, called Port Vallais (Portus Valesiæ of the Romans), once situated at the water's edge, at the upper end, is now more than a mile and a half inland—this intervening alluvial tract having been acquired in about eight centuries. The remainder of the delta consists of a flat alluvial plain, about five or six miles in length, composed of sand and mud, a little raised above the level of the river, and full of marshes.

Lake of Geneva.—Lakes are a great example of the initial processes that rivers go through when they transport debris from rocks and the minerals from springs in the mountains. The formation of new land at the mouth of the Rhone, at the upper end of Lake Geneva, or Leman Lake, shows us a significant accumulation of layers that have built up since historical times. This lake is around thirty-seven miles long and varies in width from two to eight miles. The lakebed is quite irregular, with recent measurements revealing depths ranging from 20 to 160 fathoms.335 The Rhone River, as it flows in at the upper end, is muddy and discolored; however, by the time it reaches the town of Geneva, the water is crystal clear and transparent. An ancient town called Port Vallais (Portus Valesiæ in Roman times) that used to be right at the water's edge is now over a mile and a half inland, with this stretch of alluvial land gained over about eight centuries. The rest of the delta is made up of a flat alluvial plain, around five or six miles long, consisting of sand and mud, slightly elevated above the river level, and filled with marshes.

Sir Henry De la Beche found, after numerous soundings in all parts of the lake, that there was a pretty uniform depth of from 120 to 160 fathoms throughout the central region, and on approaching the delta, the shallowing of the bottom began to be very sensible at a distance of about a mile and three quarters from the mouth of the Rhone; for a line drawn from St. Gingoulph to Vevey gives a mean depth of somewhat less than 600 feet, and from that part of the Rhone, the fluviatile mud is always found along the bottom.336 We may state, therefore, that the new strata annually produced are thrown down upon a slope about two miles in length; so that, notwithstanding the great depth of the lake, the new deposits are inclined at so slight an angle, that the dip of the beds would be termed, in ordinary geological language, horizontal.

Sir Henry De la Beche discovered, after taking many measurements all around the lake, that the central area had a pretty consistent depth ranging from 120 to 160 fathoms. As he got closer to the delta, he noticed that the bottom started to rise noticeably at about a mile and three-quarters from the mouth of the Rhone. A line drawn from St. Gingoulph to Vevey shows an average depth of just under 600 feet, and from that part of the Rhone, you can always find river mud along the bottom.336 We can say, therefore, that the new layers formed each year are deposited on a slope about two miles long. So, despite the lake's great depth, the new deposits are sloped at such a slight angle that they would generally be considered horizontal in geological terms.

The strata probably consist of alternations of finer and coarser particles; for, during the hotter months from April to August, when the snows melt, the volume and velocity of the river are greatest, and large quantities of sand, mud, vegetable matter, and drift-wood are introduced; but during the rest of the year, the influx is comparatively feeble, so much so, that the whole lake, according to Saussure, stands six feet lower. If, then, we could obtain a section of the accumulation formed in the last eight centuries, we should see a great series of strata, probably from 600 to 900 feet thick (the supposed original depth of the head of the lake), and nearly two miles in length, inclined at a very slight angle. In the mean time, a great number of 253 smaller deltas are growing around the borders of the lake, at the mouths of rapid torrents, which pour in large masses of sand and pebbles. The body of water in these torrents is too small to enable them to spread out the transported matter over so extensive an area as the Rhone does. Thus, for example, there is a depth of eighty fathoms within half a mile of the shore, immediately opposite the great torrent which enters east of Ripaille, so that the dip of the strata in that minor delta must be about four times as great as those deposited by the main river at the upper extremity of the lake.337

The layers likely consist of alternating fine and coarse particles. During the hotter months from April to August, when the snow melts, the river's volume and speed peak, bringing in large amounts of sand, mud, plant material, and driftwood. However, for the rest of the year, the influx is relatively weak, so much so that, according to Saussure, the entire lake stands six feet lower. If we could get a section of the accumulation formed over the last eight centuries, we would see a thick series of layers, likely between 600 and 900 feet deep (the estimated original depth of the lake's head) and nearly two miles long, sloping at a very slight angle. Meanwhile, numerous smaller deltas are forming around the lake's edges at the mouths of fast-moving streams, which bring in large amounts of sand and pebbles. The volume of water in these streams is too small to spread the transported material over such a large area as the Rhône does. For instance, there is a depth of eighty fathoms within half a mile of the shore, right across from the major torrent that flows in east of Ripaille, meaning the slope of the layers in that minor delta must be about four times steeper than those deposited by the main river at the upper end of the lake.337

Chronological computations of the age of deltas.—The capacity of this basin being now ascertained, it would be an interesting subject of inquiry, to determine in what number of years the Leman Lake will be converted into dry land. It would not be very difficult to obtain the elements for such a calculation, so as to approximate at least to the quantity of time required for the accomplishment of the result. The number of cubic feet of water annually discharged by the river into the lake being estimated, experiments might be made in the winter and summer months, to determine the proportion of matter held in suspension or in chemical solution by the Rhone. It would be also necessary to allow for the heavier matter drifted along at the bottom, which might be estimated on hydrostatical principles, when the average size of the gravel and the volume and velocity of the stream at different seasons were known. Supposing all these observations to have been made, it would be more easy to calculate the future than the former progress of the delta, because it would be a laborious task to ascertain, with any degree of precision, the original depth and extent of that part of the lake which is already filled up. Even if this information were actually obtained by borings, it would only enable us to approximate within a certain number of centuries to the time when the Rhone began to form its present delta; but this would not give us the date of the origin of the Leman Lake in its present form, because the river may have flowed into it for thousands of years, without importing any sediment whatever. Such would have been the case, if the waters had first passed through a chain of upper lakes; and that this was actually the fact, seems indicated by the course of the Rhone between Martigny and the Lake of Geneva, and, still more decidedly, by the channels of many of its principal feeders.

Chronological computations of the age of deltas.—Now that we’ve figured out the capacity of this basin, it would be interesting to explore how many years it will take for Lake Leman to turn into dry land. Gathering the information needed for this calculation wouldn’t be too hard, allowing us to at least estimate the time required for this change to happen. By estimating the cubic feet of water the river discharges into the lake each year, we could conduct experiments during the winter and summer to determine how much material is suspended or dissolved in the Rhone. We also need to take into account the heavier materials that settle at the bottom, which we could estimate using hydrostatic principles once we know the average size of the gravel and the volume and speed of the stream in different seasons. Assuming all these observations are made, it would be easier to predict the future than to figure out the past progress of the delta, because determining the original depth and size of the part of the lake that’s already filled would be a challenging task. Even if we managed to obtain this data from borings, it would only help us estimate the number of centuries since the Rhone began forming its current delta; it wouldn’t tell us when Lake Leman took on its current shape, as the river could have been flowing into it for thousands of years without bringing in any sediment. This would have been the case if the waters initially passed through a series of upper lakes, which seems likely based on the route of the Rhone between Martigny and Lake Geneva, and even more so by the channels of many of its main tributaries.

If we ascend, for example, the valley through which the Dranse flows, we find that it consists of a succession of basins, one above the other, in each of which there is a wide expanse of flat alluvial lands, separated from the next basin by a rocky gorge, once perhaps the barrier of a lake. The river seems to have filled these lakes, one after the other, and to have partially cut through the barriers, some of which it is still gradually eroding to a greater depth. Before, therefore, we can pretend even to hazard a conjecture as to the era at which the principal delta of Lake Leman or any other delta commenced, we must be thoroughly acquainted 254 with the geographical features and geological history of the whole system of higher valleys which communicate with the main stream, and all the changes which they have undergone since the last series of convulsions which agitated and altered the face of the country.

If we climb the valley where the Dranse flows, we see that it’s made up of a series of basins stacked on top of each other, each with a wide stretch of flat alluvial land, separated from the next basin by a rocky gorge that might have once been the edge of a lake. The river seems to have filled these lakes, one after the other, and has partially cut through the barriers, some of which it is still gradually eroding to a greater depth. So, before we can even make an educated guess about when the main delta of Lake Leman or any other delta started forming, we need to have a solid understanding of the geographical features and geological history of the entire system of higher valleys that connect with the main river, along with all the changes they have gone through since the last major upheavals that reshaped the land. 254

Lake Superior.—Lake Superior is the largest body of freshwater in the world, being above 1700 geographical miles in circumference when we follow the sinuosities of its coasts, and its length, on a curved line drawn through its centre, being more than 400, and its extreme breadth above 150 geographical miles. Its surface is nearly as large as the whole of England. Its average depth varies from 80 to 150 fathoms; but, according to Captain Bayfield, there is reason to think that its greatest depth would not be overrated at 200 fathoms, so that its bottom is, in some parts, nearly 600 feet below the level of the Atlantic, its surface being about as much above it. There are appearances in different parts of this, as of the other Canadian lakes, leading us to infer that its waters formerly occupied a higher level than they reach at present; for at a considerable distance from the present shores, parallel lines of rolled stones and shells are seen rising one above the other, like the seats of an amphitheatre. These ancient lines of shingle are exactly similar to the present beaches in most bays, and they often attain an elevation of 40 or 50 feet above the present level. As the heaviest gales of wind do not raise the waters more than three or four feet, the elevated beaches have by some been referred to the subsidence of the lake at former periods, in consequence of the wearing down of its barrier; by others to the upraising of the shores by earthquakes, like those which have produced similar phenomena on the coast of Chili.

Lake Superior.—Lake Superior is the largest freshwater lake in the world, with a circumference of over 1,700 miles when measuring the curves of its shores. It's more than 400 miles long and over 150 miles wide at its widest point. Its surface area is nearly the same as all of England. The average depth ranges from 80 to 150 fathoms, but according to Captain Bayfield, it’s believed that its maximum depth could be around 200 fathoms, meaning the bottom is nearly 600 feet below the Atlantic Ocean’s level, with the surface being about the same height above it. There are signs in various parts of this lake, similar to those found in other Canadian lakes, that suggest its waters used to be at a higher level than they are now. Far from the current shores, you can see parallel lines of rolled stones and shells stacked on top of one another, resembling the seating of an amphitheater. These ancient shingle lines look just like the current beaches found in most bays, and they often rise to heights of 40 or 50 feet above the current water level. Since the strongest winds only raise the water level by three or four feet, some people attribute these elevated beaches to the lake sinking over time due to erosion of its barrier, while others believe it’s due to the uplift of the shores from earthquakes, similar to occurrences along the coast of Chile.

The streams which discharge their waters into Lake Superior are several hundred in number, without reckoning those of smaller size; and the quantity of water supplied by them is many times greater than that discharged at the Falls of St. Mary, the only outlet. The evaporation, therefore, is very great, and such as might be expected from so vast an extent of surface. On the northern side, which is encircled by primary mountains, the rivers sweep in many large boulders with smaller gravel and sand, chiefly composed of granitic and trap rocks. There are also currents in the lake in various directions, caused by the continued prevalence of strong winds, and to their influence we may attribute the diffusion of finer mud far and wide over great areas; for by numerous soundings made during Captain Bayfield's survey, it was ascertained that the bottom consists generally of a very adhesive clay, containing shells of the species at present existing in the lake. When exposed to the air, this clay immediately becomes indurated in so great a degree, as to require a smart blow to break it. It effervesces slightly with diluted nitric acid, and is of different colors in different parts of the lake; in one district blue, in another red, and in a third white, hardening into a substance resembling pipeclay.338 From these statements, the geologist will 255 not fail to remark how closely these recent lacustrine formations in America resemble the tertiary argillaceous and calcareous marls of lacustrine origin in Central France. In both cases many of the genera of shells most abundant, as Limnea and Planorbis, are the same; and in regard to other classes of organic remains there must be the closest analogy, as I shall endeavor more fully to explain when speaking of the imbedding of plants and animals in recent deposits.

The streams that flow into Lake Superior number in the hundreds, not counting the smaller ones; the amount of water they provide is many times greater than what flows out at the St. Mary’s Falls, the lake's only outlet. Consequently, evaporation is quite significant, which is expected given the lake's large surface area. On the northern side, bordered by primary mountains, rivers carry many large boulders along with smaller gravel and sand, primarily made up of granite and trap rock. There are also currents in the lake flowing in different directions due to the ongoing strong winds, and it’s their influence that spreads finer mud widely across vast areas. Numerous soundings taken during Captain Bayfield's survey revealed that the lake's bottom is generally composed of a very sticky clay, which contains shells from species currently living in the lake. When this clay is exposed to air, it hardens significantly, needing a strong hit to break it apart. It slightly fizzes when mixed with diluted nitric acid and varies in color across different parts of the lake; in one area, it’s blue, in another red, and in yet another white, solidifying into a material that resembles pipe clay.338 From these observations, geologists will notice how closely these recent lake formations in America resemble the tertiary clay and limestone marls of lake origin in Central France. In both instances, many of the common shell genera, like Limnea and Planorbis, are the same, and regarding other types of organic remains, there is a striking similarity, which I will discuss further when I talk about the embedding of plants and animals in recent deposits.

DELTAS OF INLAND SEAS.

Having thus briefly considered some of the lacustrine deltas now in progress, we may next turn our attention to those of inland seas.

Having briefly looked at some of the deltas that are currently forming in lakes, we can now shift our focus to those of inland seas.

Course of the Po.—The Po affords an instructive example of the manner in which a great river bears down to the sea the matter poured into it by a multitude of tributaries descending from lofty chains of mountains. The changes gradually effected in the great plain of Northern Italy, since the time of the Roman republic, are considerable. Extensive lakes and marshes have been gradually filled up, as those near Placentia, Parma, and Cremona, and many have been drained naturally by the deepening of the beds of rivers. Deserted river-courses are not unfrequent, as that of the Serio Morto, which formerly fell into the Adda, in Lombardy. The Po also itself has often deviated from its course, having after the year 1390 deserted part of the territory of Cremona, and invaded that of Parma; its old channel being still recognizable, and bearing the name of Po Morto. There is also an old channel of the Po in the territory of Parma, called Po Vecchio, which was abandoned in the twelfth century, when a great number of towns were destroyed.

Course of the Po.—The Po is a great example of how a major river transports materials to the sea from numerous tributaries flowing down from high mountain ranges. The changes that have happened in the large plain of Northern Italy since the time of the Roman republic are significant. Large lakes and marshes, like those near Placentia, Parma, and Cremona, have gradually been filled in, and many have drained naturally due to the deepening of riverbeds. Abandoned river channels are not uncommon, such as the Serio Morto, which used to flow into the Adda in Lombardy. The Po itself has changed its course many times; after 1390, it shifted away from part of Cremona and into the territory of Parma, with its old channel still identifiable and known as Po Morto. There’s also an old channel of the Po in the Parma area called Po Vecchio, which was abandoned in the twelfth century when many towns were destroyed.

Artificial embankments of Italian rivers.—To check these and similar aberrations, a general system of embankment has been adopted; and the Po, Adige, and almost all their tributaries, are now confined between high artificial banks. The increased velocity acquired by streams thus closed in, enables them to convey a much larger portion of foreign matter to the sea; and, consequently, the deltas of the Po and Adige have gained far more rapidly on the Adriatic since the practice of embankment became almost universal. But, although more sediment is borne to the sea, part of the sand and mud, which in the natural state of things would be spread out by annual inundations over the plain, now subsides in the bottom of the river-channels; and their capacity being thereby diminished, it is necessary, in order to prevent inundations in the following spring, to extract matter from the bed, and to add it to the banks of the river. Hence it happens that these streams now traverse the plain on the top of high mounds, like the waters of aqueducts, and at Ferrara the surface of the Po has become more elevated than the roofs of the houses.339 The magnitude of these barriers is a subject 256 of increasing expense and anxiety, it having been sometimes found necessary to give an additional height of nearly one foot to the banks of the Adige and Po in a single season.

Artificial embankments of Italian rivers.—To address these and similar issues, a general system of embankment has been implemented; now, the Po, Adige, and almost all their tributaries are confined between high artificial banks. The increased speed gained by the streams that are enclosed allows them to carry a much larger amount of foreign material to the sea. As a result, the deltas of the Po and Adige have expanded much more quickly into the Adriatic since embankment has become nearly universal. However, even though more sediment is being transported to the sea, some of the sand and mud that would naturally spread across the plains during annual floods now settles at the bottom of the river channels. This reduces their capacity, so to prevent flooding the following spring, it’s necessary to remove material from the riverbed and add it to the riverbanks. Consequently, these rivers now flow across the plains on top of high mounds, resembling aqueduct waters, and in Ferrara, the surface of the Po has become higher than the roofs of the houses.339 The size of these barriers is a growing concern and expense, as it has sometimes been necessary to raise the banks of the Adige and Po by nearly one foot in a single season.

The practice of embankment was adopted on some of the Italian rivers as early as the thirteenth century; and Dante, writing in the beginning of the fourteenth, describes, in the seventh circle of hell, a rivulet of tears separated from a burning sandy desert by embankments "like those which, between Ghent and Bruges, were raised against the ocean, or those which the Paduans had erected along the Brenta to defend their villas on the melting of the Alpine snows."

The practice of building embankments was used on some Italian rivers as early as the 1300s; and Dante, writing at the start of the 1400s, describes, in the seventh circle of hell, a stream of tears separated from a burning sandy desert by embankments "like those raised between Ghent and Bruges to hold back the ocean, or like those that the people of Padua built along the Brenta to protect their villas from the melting Alpine snow."

Quali i Fiamminghi tra Guzzante e Bruggia, Fearful of the surge that rushes towards them, Fanno lo schermo, because the sea was escaping, __A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__. And which the Padovans along the Brenta, To defend their towns and their castles, Instead of Chiarentana feeling the heat.— Inferno, Canto 15.


In the Adriatic, from the northern part of the Gulf of Trieste, where the Isonzo enters, down to the south of Ravenna, there is an uninterrupted series of recent accessions of land, more than 100 miles in length, which, within the last 2000 years, have increased from two to twenty miles in breadth. A line of sand-bars of great length has been formed nearly all along the western coast of this gulf, inside of which are lagunes, such as those of Venice, and the large lagune of Comacchio, 20 miles in diameter. Newly deposited mud brought down by the streams is continually lessening the depth of the lagunes, and converting part of them into meadows.340 The Isonzo, Tagliamento, Piave, Brenta, Adige, and Po, besides many other inferior rivers, contribute to this advance of the coast-line and to the shallowing of the lagunes and the gulf.


In the Adriatic, from the northern part of the Gulf of Trieste, where the Isonzo River flows in, down to the south of Ravenna, there's an unbroken stretch of newly emerged land, spanning over 100 miles, that has expanded in the last 2000 years from two to twenty miles wide. A long line of sandbars has formed along almost the entire western coast of this gulf, behind which are lagoons, including those of Venice, and the large lagoon of Comacchio, which is 20 miles in diameter. The constant deposition of mud brought in by rivers is gradually reducing the depth of the lagoons and turning some of them into meadows.340 The Isonzo, Tagliamento, Piave, Brenta, Adige, and Po, along with many other smaller rivers, play a key role in this expansion of the coastline and in the shallowing of the lagoons and the gulf.

Delta of the Po.—The Po and the Adige may now be considered as entering by one common delta, for two branches of the Adige are connected with arms of the Po, and thus the principal delta has been pushed out beyond those bars which separate the lagunes from the sea. The rate of the advance of this new land has been accelerated, as before stated, since the system of embanking the rivers became general, especially at that point where the Po and Adige enter. The waters are no longer permitted to spread themselves far and wide over the plains, and to leave behind them the larger portion of their sediment. Mountain torrents also have become more turbid since the clearing away of forests, which once clothed the southern flanks of the Alps. It is calculated that the mean rate of advance of the delta of the Po on the Adriatic between the years 1200 and 1600 was 25 yards or metres a year, whereas the mean annual gain from 1600 to 1804 was 70 metres.341

Delta of the Po.—The Po and Adige rivers can now be seen as merging into a single delta, since two branches of the Adige connect with parts of the Po, pushing the main delta out beyond the bars that separate the lagoons from the sea. The rate at which this new land is forming has increased, as previously mentioned, since river embankment became common, especially where the Po and Adige meet. The waters no longer spread out over the plains as they used to, leaving much of their sediment behind. Mountain streams have also become muddier since forests, which once covered the southern slopes of the Alps, were cut down. It's estimated that the average rate of delta growth of the Po at the Adriatic between 1200 and 1600 was 25 yards or meters per year, while the average annual gain from 1600 to 1804 was 70 meters.341

257Adria was a seaport in the time of Augustus, and had, in ancient times, given its name to the gulf; it is now about twenty Italian miles inland. Ravenna was also a seaport, and is now about four miles from the main sea. Yet even before the practice of embankment was introduced, the alluvium of the Po advanced with rapidity on the Adriatic; for Spina, a very ancient city, originally built in the district of Ravenna, at the mouth of a great arm of the Po, was, so early as the commencement of our era, eleven miles distant from the sea.342

257Adria was a seaport during Augustus's time and gave its name to the gulf in ancient times; it’s now about twenty Italian miles inland. Ravenna was also a seaport, and it’s currently around four miles from the main sea. Even before embankments were built, the sediment from the Po River was quickly advancing toward the Adriatic. For instance, Spina, an ancient city originally established in the Ravenna area at the mouth of a major arm of the Po, was, as early as the start of our era, eleven miles from the sea.342

But although so many rivers are rapidly converting the Adriatic into land, it appears, by the observations of M. Morlot, that since the time of the Romans, there has been a general subsidence of the coast and bed of this sea in the same region to the amount of five feet, so that the advance of the new-made land has not been so fast as it would have been had the level of the coast remained unaltered. The signs of a much greater depression anterior to the historical period have also been brought to light by an Artesian well, bored in 1847, to the depth of more than 400 feet, which still failed to penetrate through the modern fluviatile deposit. The auger passed chiefly through beds of sand and clay, but at four several depths, one of them very near the bottom of the excavation, it pierced beds of turf, or accumulations of vegetable matter, precisely similar to those now formed superficially on the extreme borders of the Adriatic. Hence we learn that a considerable area of what was once land has sunk down 400 feet in the course of ages.343

But even though so many rivers are quickly turning the Adriatic into land, it seems, according to M. Morlot's observations, that since the time of the Romans, the coast and the seabed in this region have generally sunk by about five feet. This means that the growth of new land hasn’t happened as fast as it could have if the coast’s level hadn’t changed. There’s also evidence of a much larger drop before recorded history, revealed by an Artesian well drilled in 1847 to a depth of over 400 feet, which still didn’t reach through the modern river deposits. The drill mostly went through layers of sand and clay, but at four different depths, including one close to the bottom of the hole, it hit layers of peat or clusters of plant material, exactly like those forming today on the outer edges of the Adriatic. This tells us that a significant area of what used to be land has sunk down 400 feet over time.343

The greatest depth of the Adriatic, between Dalmatia and the mouths of the Po, is twenty-two fathoms; but a large part of the Gulf of Trieste and the Adriatic, opposite Venice, is less than twelve fathoms deep. Farther to the south, where it is less affected by the influx of great rivers, the gulf deepens considerably. Donati, after dredging the bottom, discovered the new deposits to consist partly of mud and partly of rock, the rock being formed of calcareous matter, incrusting shells. He also ascertained, that particular species of testacea were grouped together in certain places, and were becoming slowly incorporated with the mud or calcareous precipitates.344 Olivi, also, found some deposits of sand, and others of mud, extending half way across the gulf; and he states that their distribution along the bottom was evidently determined by the prevailing current.345 It is probable, therefore, that the finer sediment of all the rivers at the head of the Adriatic may be intermingled by the influence of the current; and all the central parts of the gulf may be considered as slowly filling up with horizontal deposits, similar to those of the Subapennine hills, and containing many of the same species of shells. The Po merely introduces at present fine sand and mud, for it carries no pebbles farther than the spot where it joins the Trebia, west of Piacenza. Near the northern borders of the basin, the Isonzo, 258 Tagliamento, and many other streams, are forming immense beds of sand and some conglomerate; for here some high mountains of Alpine limestone approach within a few miles of the sea.

The deepest part of the Adriatic Sea, between Dalmatia and the Po river mouths, is twenty-two fathoms; however, much of the Gulf of Trieste and the Adriatic near Venice is less than twelve fathoms deep. Further south, where it's less impacted by large rivers, the gulf gets much deeper. After dredging the seabed, Donati found that the new deposits were partly mud and partly rock, with the rock made of calcium-rich material and covered in shells. He also noticed that specific types of shellfish were clustered in certain areas, slowly mixing with the mud or calcium-based sediments.344 Olivi also discovered sand deposits and other mud extending halfway across the gulf, noting that their distribution on the seabed was clearly influenced by the prevailing current.345 Therefore, it’s likely that the finer sediments from all the rivers at the head of the Adriatic are being mixed by the current, and the central parts of the gulf are gradually filling up with horizontal deposits similar to those in the Subapennine hills, containing many of the same shell species. The Po river currently only brings fine sand and mud, as it doesn’t carry pebbles beyond where it meets the Trebia, west of Piacenza. Near the northern edges of the basin, the Isonzo, Tagliamento, and several other streams are creating large beds of sand and some conglomerates, as here, high mountains of Alpine limestone come within a few miles of the sea.

In the time of the Romans, the hot-baths of Monfalcone were on one of several islands of Alpine limestone, between which and the mainland, on the north, was a channel of the sea, about a mile broad. This channel is now converted into a grassy plain, which surrounds the islands on all sides. Among the numerous changes on this coast, we find that the present channel of the Isonzo is several miles to the west of its ancient bed, in part of which, at Ronchi, the old Roman bridge which crossed the Via Appia was lately found buried in fluviatile silt.

In Roman times, the hot baths of Monfalcone were located on one of several islands made of Alpine limestone, separated from the mainland to the north by a sea channel about a mile wide. This channel has now turned into a grassy plain that encircles the islands. Among the many changes along this coast, we see that the current path of the Isonzo River is several miles west of its original course, part of which, at Ronchi, recently revealed the old Roman bridge that once crossed the Via Appia, now buried in river silt.

Marine delta of the Rhone.—The lacustrine delta of the Rhone in Switzerland has already been considered (p. 251), its contemporaneous marine delta may now be described. Scarcely has the river passed out of the Lake of Geneva before its pure waters are again filled with sand and sediment by the impetuous Arve, descending from the highest Alps, and bearing along in its current the granitic detritus annually brought down by the glaciers of Mont Blanc. The Rhone afterwards receives vast contributions of transported matter from the Alps of Dauphiny, and the primary and volcanic mountains of Central France; and when at length it enters the Mediterranean, it discolors the blue waters of that sea with a whitish sediment, for the distance of between six and seven miles, throughout which space the current of fresh water is perceptible.

Marine delta of the Rhone.—The lake delta of the Rhone in Switzerland has already been discussed (p. 251); now we can talk about its marine delta. As soon as the river flows out of Lake Geneva, its clear waters quickly become mixed with sand and sediment carried by the fast-flowing Arve, which comes down from the highest Alps and drags along granitic debris that the Mont Blanc glaciers dump every year. The Rhone then collects a huge amount of transported material from the Dauphiny Alps and the primary and volcanic mountains of Central France. By the time it reaches the Mediterranean, it clouds the blue waters of the sea with a whitish sediment, which extends for about six to seven miles, where you can still feel the flow of fresh water.

Strabo's description of the delta is so inapplicable to its present configuration, as to attest a complete alteration in the physical features of the country since the Augustan age. It appears, however, that the head of the delta, or the point at which it begins to ramify, has remained unaltered since the time of Pliny, for he states that the Rhone divided itself at Arles into two arms. This is the case at present; one of the branches, the western, being now called Le Petit Rhône, which is again subdivided before entering the Mediterranean. The advance of the base of the delta, in the last eighteen centuries, is demonstrated by many curious antiquarian monuments. The most striking of these is the great and unnatural détour of the old Roman road from Ugernum to Beziers (Bœterræ) which went round by Nismes (Nemausus). It is clear that, when this was first constructed, it was impossible to pass in a direct line, as now, across the delta, and that either the sea or marshes intervened in a tract now consisting of terra firma.346 Astruc also remarks, that all the places on low lands, lying to the north of the old Roman road between Nismes and Beziers, have names of Celtic origin, evidently given to them by the first inhabitants of the country; whereas, the places lying south of that road, towards the sea, have names of Latin derivation, and were clearly founded after the Roman language had been introduced.

Strabo's description of the delta doesn’t fit its current layout at all, indicating a complete change in the area's physical features since the Augustan era. However, it seems that the head of the delta, where it starts to branch out, has stayed the same since Pliny's time, as he noted that the Rhone split at Arles into two arms. This is still true today; one of the branches, the western one, is now called Le Petit Rhône, which further divides before reaching the Mediterranean. The shift in the delta's base over the last eighteen centuries is shown by many interesting archaeological sites. The most notable of these is the significant detour of the ancient Roman road from Ugernum to Beziers (Bœterræ), which went around Nismes (Nemausus). It’s clear that when this road was first built, it wasn’t possible to travel directly across the delta as we can now, because either the sea or marshes would have blocked the way in an area that is now solid ground.346 Astruc also points out that all the places on low land north of the old Roman road between Nismes and Beziers have names of Celtic origin, likely given by the country’s earliest inhabitants; whereas the places south of that road, closer to the sea, have names of Latin origin and were clearly established after the Roman language was introduced.

259 Another proof, also, of the great extent of land which has come into existence since the Romans conquered and colonized Gaul, is derived from the fact, that the Roman writers never mention the thermal waters of Balaruc in the delta, although they were well acquainted with those of Aix, and others still more distant, and attached great importance to them, as they invariably did to all hot springs. The waters of Balaruc, therefore, must have formerly issued under the sea—a common phenomenon on the borders of the Mediterranean; and on the advance of the delta they continued to flow out through the new deposits.

259 Another indication of the significant amount of land that has emerged since the Romans conquered and settled in Gaul is that Roman writers never mentioned the thermal waters of Balaruc in the delta, even though they were familiar with those of Aix and other more distant sites, which they valued highly, as they did with all hot springs. Thus, the waters of Balaruc must have once flowed beneath the sea—a common occurrence along the Mediterranean coast; as the delta expanded, they continued to seep through the new deposits.

Among the more direct proofs of the increase of land, we find that Mese, described under the appellation of Mesua Collis by Pomponius Mela,347 and stated by him to be nearly an island, is now far inland. Notre Dame des Ports, also, was a harbor in 898, but is now a league from the shore. Psalmodi was an island in 815, and is now two leagues from the sea. Several old lines of towers and sea-marks occur at different distances from the present coast, all indicating the successive retreat of the sea, for each line has in its turn become useless to mariners; which may well be conceived, when we state that the Tower of Tignaux, erected on the shore so late as the year 1737, is already a mile remote from it.348

Among the more straightforward proofs of land increasing, we see that Mese, referred to as Mesua Collis by Pomponius Mela,347 and noted by him as being almost an island, is now located far inland. Notre Dame des Ports was a harbor in 898, but now it’s a league away from the shore. Psalmodi was an island in 815, and it is now two leagues from the sea. Several old lines of towers and sea markers appear at various distances from the current coast, all showing the gradual retreat of the sea, as each line has eventually become obsolete for sailors; this is understandable when we mention that the Tower of Tignaux, built on the shore as recently as 1737, is already a mile away from it.348

By the confluence of the Rhone and the currents of the Mediterranean, driven by winds from the south, sand-bars are often formed across the mouths of the river; by these means considerable spaces become divided off from the sea, and subsequently from the river also, when it shifts its channels of efflux. As some of these lagoons are subject to the occasional ingress of the river when flooded, and of the sea during storms, they are alternately salt and fresh. Others, after being filled with salt water, are often lowered by evaporation till they become more salt than the sea; and it has happened, occasionally, that a considerable precipitate of muriate of soda has taken place in these natural salterns. During the latter part of Napoleon's career, when the excise laws were enforced with extreme rigor, the police was employed to prevent such salt from being used. The fluviatile and marine shells inclosed in these small lakes often live together in brackish water; but the uncongenial nature of the fluid usually produces a dwarfish size, and sometimes gives rise to strange varieties in form and color.

At the point where the Rhone meets the currents of the Mediterranean, driven by southern winds, sandbars often form at the river's mouth. This creates significant areas that become separated from the sea, and later from the river itself, as it changes its flow. Some of these lagoons sometimes get flooded by the river during high water and by the sea during storms, so they alternate between saltwater and freshwater. Others, after being filled with saltwater, can evaporate until they become saltier than the sea, and at times, a considerable amount of sodium chloride (table salt) can deposit in these natural salt flats. During the later part of Napoleon's rule, when excise laws were strictly enforced, police were used to prevent such salt from being utilized. The freshwater and seawater shells found in these small lakes often coexist in brackish water, but the harsh nature of the fluid generally results in smaller sizes and can lead to unusual varieties in shape and color.

Captain Smyth in his survey of the coast of the Mediterranean, found the sea opposite the mouth of the Rhone, to deepen gradually from four to forty fathoms, within a distance of six or seven miles, over which the discolored fresh water extends; so that the inclination of the new deposits must be too slight to be appreciable in such an extent of section as a geologist usually obtains in examining ancient formations. When the wind blew from the southwest, the ships employed 260 in the survey were obliged to quit their moorings; and when they returned, the new sand-banks in the delta were found covered over with a great abundance of marine shells. By this means, we learn how occasional beds of drifted marine shells may become interstratified with freshwater strata at a river's mouth.

Captain Smyth, while surveying the Mediterranean coast, discovered that the sea near the mouth of the Rhone gradually deepens from four to forty fathoms over a distance of six or seven miles, where the murky freshwater extends. This suggests that the slope of the new deposits is too slight to be noticeable over such a large section that a geologist typically examines in ancient formations. When the wind came from the southwest, the ships used in the survey had to leave their moorings; upon returning, they found that the new sandbanks in the delta were covered with a large number of marine shells. This illustrates how occasional layers of drifted marine shells can become interlayered with freshwater sediments at the mouth of a river.

Stony nature of its deposits.—That a great proportion, at least, of the new deposit in the delta of the Rhone consists of rock, and not of loose incoherent matter, is perfectly ascertained. In the Museum at Montpelier is a cannon taken up from the sea near the mouth of the river, imbedded in a crystalline calcareous rock. Large masses, also, are continually taken up of an arenaceous rock, cemented by calcareous matter, including multitudes of broken shells of recent species. The observations lately made on this subject corroborate the former statement of Marsilli, that the earthy deposits of the coast of Languedoc form a stony substance, for which reason he ascribes a certain bituminous, saline, and glutinous nature to the substances brought down with sand by the Rhone.349 If the number of mineral springs charged with carbonate of lime which fall into the Rhone and its feeders in different parts of France be considered, we shall feel no surprise at the lapidification of the newly deposited sediment in this delta. It should be remembered, that the fresh water introduced by rivers being lighter than the water of the sea, floats over the latter, and remains upon the surface for a considerable distance. Consequently it is exposed to as much evaporation as the waters of a lake; and the area over which the river-water is spread, at the junction of great rivers and the sea, may well be compared, in point of extent, to that of considerable lakes.

Stony nature of its deposits.—It’s clearly established that a large part, at least, of the new deposits in the delta of the Rhone consists of rock, rather than loose, incoherent material. In the Museum at Montpelier, there’s a cannon retrieved from the sea near the mouth of the river, embedded in crystalline limestone. Large chunks of sandy rock, cemented by calcium deposits, are also continually being brought up, containing countless broken shells of species that are still recent. Recent observations confirm Marsilli’s earlier claim that the earthy deposits along the coast of Languedoc form a stony substance, which is why he attributes a certain bituminous, salty, and sticky nature to the materials carried downstream with the sand by the Rhone.349 Considering the number of mineral springs rich in calcium carbonate that flow into the Rhone and its tributaries throughout different parts of France, it’s no surprise that the newly deposited sediment in this delta has become stony. It’s important to remember that fresh water brought in by rivers is lighter than seawater, so it floats on top, remaining on the surface for quite a distance. As a result, it undergoes just as much evaporation as the waters of a lake; the area covered by river water at the confluence of large rivers and the sea can easily be compared in size to that of significant lakes.

Now, it is well known, that so great is the quantity of water carried off by evaporation in some lakes, that it is nearly equal to the water flowing in; and in some inland seas, as the Caspian, it is quite equal. We may, therefore, well suppose that, in cases where a strong current does not interfere, the greater portion not only of the matter held mechanically in suspension, but of that also which is in chemical solution, may be precipitated at no great distance from the shore. When these finer ingredients are extremely small in quantity, they may only suffice to supply crustaceous animals, corals, and marine plants, with the earthy particles necessary for their secretions; but whenever it is in excess (as generally happens if the basin of a river lie partly in a district of active or extinct volcanoes), then will solid deposits be formed, and the shells will at once be included in a rocky mass.

Now, it's well known that in some lakes, the amount of water lost through evaporation is almost equal to the water coming in. In some inland seas, like the Caspian Sea, it's exactly equal. So, we can reasonably assume that when a strong current isn't affecting things, most of the material that’s mechanically suspended, as well as what’s dissolved in the water, might settle out not far from the shore. When these smaller particles are in very low quantities, they might only provide the minerals needed by crustaceans, corals, and marine plants for their formations; but when there's an excess (which usually happens if the river basin is partially in a region with active or extinct volcanoes), solid deposits will form, and the shells will be quickly incorporated into a rocky mass.

Coast of Asia Minor.—Examples of the advance of the land upon the sea are afforded by the southern coast of Asia Minor. Admiral Sir F. Beaufort has pointed out in his survey the great alterations effected since the time of Strabo, where havens are filled up, islands joined to the mainland, and where the whole continent has increased many miles in extent. Strabo himself, on comparing the outline of the coast in his time with its ancient state, was convinced, like our countryman, 261 that it had gained very considerably upon the sea. The new-formed strata of Asia Minor consist of stone, not of loose incoherent materials. Almost all the streamlets and rivers, like many of those in Tuscany and the south of Italy, hold abundance of carbonate of lime in solution, and precipitate travertin, or sometimes bind together the sand and gravel into solid sandstones and conglomerates; every delta and sand-bar thus acquires solidity, which often prevents streams from forcing their way through them, so that their mouths are constantly changing their position.350

Coast of Asia Minor.—The southern coast of Asia Minor offers examples of how land has expanded into the sea. Admiral Sir F. Beaufort noted in his survey the significant changes that have occurred since Strabo's time, with bays being filled in, islands merging with the mainland, and the entire continent extending several miles. Strabo himself observed the coastline during his era and compared it to its earlier form, concluding, like our fellow countryman, that it had grown substantially closer to the sea. The newly formed layers in Asia Minor are made of stone, rather than loose, disordered materials. Almost all the small streams and rivers, similar to many in Tuscany and southern Italy, carry a lot of dissolved calcium carbonate, which forms travertine and sometimes solidifies together sand and gravel into tough sandstones and conglomerates; this gives every delta and sandbar a firm structure, often blocking streams from flowing through, which causes their mouths to shift positions regularly.350

Delta of the Nile.—That Egypt was "the gift of the Nile," was the opinion of her priests before the time of Herodotus; and Rennell observes, that the "configuration and composition of the low lands leave no room for doubt that the sea once washed the base of the rocks on which the pyramids of Memphis stand, the present base of which is washed by the inundation of the Nile, at an elevation of 70 or 80 feet above the Mediterranean. But when we attempt to carry back our ideas to the remote period when the foundation of the delta was first laid, we are lost in the contemplation of so vast an interval of time."351 Herodotus observes, "that the country round Memphis seemed formerly to have been an arm of the sea gradually filled by the Nile, in the same manner as the Meander, Achelous, and other streams, had formed deltas. Egypt, therefore, he says, like the Red Sea, was once a long narrow bay, and both gulfs were separated by a small neck of land. If the Nile, he adds, should by any means have an issue into the Arabian Gulf, it might choke it up with earth in 20,000 or even, perhaps, in 10,000 years; and why may not the Nile have filled a still greater gulf with mud in the space of time which has passed before our age?"352

Delta of the Nile.—Egypt was considered "the gift of the Nile" by its priests long before Herodotus. Rennell points out that the "shape and makeup of the lowlands make it clear that the sea once lapped at the base of the rocks where the pyramids of Memphis stand, which are currently supported by the floodwaters of the Nile, 70 to 80 feet above the Mediterranean. However, when we try to imagine the distant time when the delta was first formed, we can easily get lost in the enormity of that time span."351 Herodotus notes, "the area around Memphis appears to have once been part of the sea, gradually filled in by the Nile, similar to how the Meander, Achelous, and other rivers have created deltas. He asserts that Egypt, like the Red Sea, was once a long, narrow bay, with both gulfs separated by a small stretch of land. He adds that if the Nile were to somehow flow into the Arabian Gulf, it could fill it with sediment in 20,000 years or even, possibly, in just 10,000 years; and why couldn't the Nile have also filled an even larger gulf with mud over the time that has passed since then?"352

The distance between Memphis and the most prominent part of the delta in a straight line north and south, is about 100 geographical miles; the length of the base of the delta is more than 200 miles if we follow the coast between the ancient extreme eastern and western arms; but as these are now blocked up, that part only of Lower Egypt which intervenes between the Rosetta and Damietta branches, is usually called the delta, the coast line of which is about 90 miles in length. The bed of the river itself, says Sir J. G. Wilkinson, undergoes a gradual increase of elevation varying in different places, and always lessening in proportion as the river approaches the sea. "This increase of elevation in perpendicular height is much smaller in Lower than in Upper Egypt, and in the delta it diminishes still more; so that, according to an approximate calculation, the land about Elephantine, or the first cataract, lat. 24° 5', has been raised nine feet in 1700 years; at Thebes, lat. 25° 43', about seven feet; and at Heliopolis and Cairo, lat. 30°, about five feet ten inches. At Rosetta and the mouths of the Nile, lat. 31° 30', the diminution in the perpendicular thickness of the deposit is lessened 262 in a much greater decreasing ratio than in the straitened valley of Central and Upper Egypt, owing to the great extent, east and west, over which the inundation spreads."353

The distance between Memphis and the most notable part of the delta, going straight north and south, is about 100 miles. The length of the delta's base is over 200 miles if you trace the coast between the ancient far eastern and western branches; however, since these are now blocked, the section of Lower Egypt between the Rosetta and Damietta branches is typically referred to as the delta, with a coastline of about 90 miles. According to Sir J. G. Wilkinson, the riverbed gradually rises to different heights depending on the area, and this elevation decreases as the river gets closer to the sea. "This increase in height is much smaller in Lower Egypt than in Upper Egypt, and it diminishes even more in the delta, so that, based on rough estimates, the land around Elephantine, or the first cataract, at latitude 24° 5', has risen nine feet over the past 1700 years; in Thebes, at latitude 25° 43', around seven feet; and in Heliopolis and Cairo, at latitude 30°, about five feet ten inches. At Rosetta and the mouths of the Nile, at latitude 31° 30', the reduction in the thickness of the deposits decreases at a much greater rate than in the narrow valley of Central and Upper Egypt, due to the large area, east and west, over which the flooding spreads." 262 353

For this reason the alluvial deposit does not cause the delta to protrude rapidly into the sea, although some ancient cities are now a mile or more inland, and the mouths of the Nile, mentioned by the earlier geographers, have been many of them silted up, and the outline of the coast entirely changed.

For this reason, the alluvial deposit doesn’t make the delta extend quickly into the sea, even though some ancient cities are now a mile or more inland, and many of the mouths of the Nile, noted by earlier geographers, have become silted up, completely altering the coastline.

The bed of the Nile always keeps pace with the general elevation of the soil, and the banks of this river, like those of the Mississippi and its tributaries (see p. 265, are much higher than the flat land at a distance, so that they are seldom covered during the highest inundations. In consequence of the gradual rise of the river's bed, the annual flood is constantly spreading over a wider area, and the alluvial soil encroaches on the desert, covering, to the depth of six or seven feet, the base of statues and temples which the waters never reached 3000 years ago. Although the sands of the Libyan deserts have in some places been drifted into the valley of the Nile, yet these aggressions, says Wilkinson, are far more than counterbalanced by the fertilizing effect of the water which now reaches farther inland towards the desert, so that the number of square miles of arable soil is greater at present than at any previous period.

The bed of the Nile always rises along with the general elevation of the soil, and the banks of this river, like those of the Mississippi and its tributaries (see p. 265), are much higher than the flat land nearby, so they are rarely covered during the highest floods. Because the riverbed gradually rises, the annual flood continually spreads over a wider area, and the fertile soil encroaches on the desert, covering up to six or seven feet deep the bases of statues and temples that the waters never reached 3000 years ago. Although some sand from the Libyan deserts has drifted into the Nile valley, these incursions, according to Wilkinson, are far outweighed by the fertilizing effect of the water that now reaches further inland toward the desert, allowing for more square miles of arable land than ever before.

Mud of the Nile.—On comparing the different analyses which have been published of this mud, it will be found that it contains a large quantity of argillaceous matter, with much peroxide of iron, some carbonate of lime, and a small proportion of carbonate of magnesia. The latest and most careful analysis by M. Lassaigne shows a singularly close resemblance in the proportions of the ingredients of silica, alumina, iron, carbon, lime, and magnesia, and those observed in ordinary mica;354 but a much larger quantity of calcareous matter is sometimes present.

Mud of the Nile.—When we look at the different analyses that have been published about this mud, we see that it has a significant amount of clayey material, a lot of iron oxide, some calcium carbonate, and a small amount of magnesium carbonate. The latest and most thorough analysis by M. Lassaigne reveals a striking similarity in the proportions of silica, alumina, iron, carbon, lime, and magnesia compared to what is found in regular mica;354 but sometimes there is a much higher quantity of calcium compounds present.

In many places, as at Cairo, where artificial excavations have been made, or where the river has undermined its banks, the mud is seen to be thinly stratified, the upper part of each annual layer consisting of earth of a lighter color than the lower, and the whole separating easily from the deposit of the succeeding year. These annual layers are variable in thickness; but, according to the calculations of Girard and Wilkinson, the mean annual thickness of a layer at Cairo cannot exceed that of a sheet of thin pasteboard, and a stratum of two or three feet must represent the accumulation of a thousand years.

In many places, like Cairo, where artificial excavations have been made or where the river has eroded its banks, the mud appears to be loosely layered. The top part of each year’s layer is made up of lighter-colored soil compared to the lower part, and the entire layer separates easily from the deposit of the following year. These yearly layers vary in thickness; however, based on the calculations of Girard and Wilkinson, the average annual thickness of a layer in Cairo can't be more than that of a piece of thin cardboard, and a layer of two or three feet must represent the buildup over a thousand years.

The depth of the Mediterranean is about twelve fathoms at a small distance from the shore of the delta; it afterwards increases gradually to 50, and then suddenly descends to 380 fathoms, which is, perhaps, the original depth of the sea where it has not been rendered shallower by fluviatile matter. We learn from Lieut. Newbold that nothing but the 263 finest and lightest ingredients reach the Mediterranean, where he has observed the sea discolored by them to the distance of 40 miles from the shore.355 The small progress of the delta in the last 2000 years affords, perhaps, no measure for estimating its rate of growth when it was an inland bay, and had not yet protruded itself beyond the coast-line of the Mediterranean. A powerful current now sweeps along the shores of Africa, from the Straits of Gibraltar to the prominent convexity of Egypt, the western side of which is continually the prey of the waves; so that not only are fresh accessions of land checked, but ancient parts of the delta are carried away. By this cause, Canopus and some other towns have been overwhelmed; but to this subject I shall again refer when speaking of tides and currents.

The Mediterranean is about twelve fathoms deep just off the delta's shore. It gradually gets deeper to 50 fathoms, then suddenly drops to 380 fathoms, which might be the original depth of the sea where it's not been shallowed by river sediment. Lieutenant Newbold tells us that only the finest and lightest materials reach the Mediterranean, and he has seen the sea change color up to 40 miles from the shore. The limited growth of the delta over the last 2,000 years probably doesn’t reflect its growth rate when it was still an inland bay and hadn’t yet extended beyond the Mediterranean coastline. A strong current now flows along the African shores, from the Straits of Gibraltar to the curved coast of Egypt, where the western side constantly suffers from waves. Because of this, not only are new land formations hindered, but parts of the delta are also eroded away. As a result, towns like Canopus and others have been submerged; I will discuss this topic again when addressing tides and currents.


CHAPTER XVIII.

REPRODUCTIVE EFFECTS OF RIVERS—continued.

Deltas formed under the influence of tides—Basin and delta of the Mississippi—Alluvial plain—River-banks and bluffs—Curves of the river—Natural rafts and snags—New lakes, and effects of earthquakes—Antiquity of the delta—Delta of the Ganges and Brahmapootra—Head of the delta and Sunderbunds—Islands formed and destroyed—Crocodiles—Amount of fluviatile sediment in the water—Artesian boring at Calcutta—Proofs of subsidence—Age of the delta—Convergence of deltas—Origin of existing deltas not contemporaneous—Grouping of strata and stratification in deltas—Conglomerates—Constant interchange of land and sea.

Deltas formed by the tides—Basin and delta of the Mississippi—Alluvial plain—Riverbanks and bluffs—Curves of the river—Natural rafts and snags—New lakes and earthquake effects—History of the delta—Delta of the Ganges and Brahmaputra—Head of the delta and Sunderbans—Islands formed and lost—Crocodiles—Amount of river sediment in the water—Artesian boring in Calcutta—Evidence of sinking—Age of the delta—Convergence of deltas—Formation of current deltas not happening at the same time—Grouping of layers and stratification in deltas—Conglomerates—Constant exchange between land and sea.

In the last chapter several examples were given of the deltas of inland seas, where the influence of the tides is almost imperceptible. We may next consider those marine or oceanic deltas, where the tides play an important part in the dispersion of fluviatile sediment, as in the Gulf of Mexico, where they exert a moderate degree of force, and then in the Bay of Bengal, where they are extremely powerful. In regard to estuaries, which Rennel termed "negative deltas," they will be treated of more properly when our attention is specially turned to the operations of tides and currents (chapters 20, 21, and 22). In this case, instead of the land gaining on the sea at the river's mouth, the tides penetrate far inland beyond the general coast-line.

In the last chapter, we looked at several examples of deltas in inland seas, where the tidal influence is barely noticeable. Now, let's focus on marine or oceanic deltas, where tides significantly affect the spread of river sediment. For instance, in the Gulf of Mexico, tides have a moderate impact, while in the Bay of Bengal, they're extremely powerful. Regarding estuaries, which Rennel referred to as "negative deltas," we'll discuss these more thoroughly when we specifically examine the effects of tides and currents (chapters 20, 21, and 22). In this situation, instead of the land advancing into the sea at the river's mouth, the tides push far inland beyond the general coastline.

BASIN AND DELTA OF THE MISSISSIPPI.

Alluvial plain.—The hydrographical basin of the Mississippi displays, on the grandest scale, the action of running water on the surface of a vast continent. This magnificent river rises nearly in the forty-ninth 264 parallel of north latitude, and flows to the Gulf of Mexico in the twenty-ninth—a course, including its meanders, of more than three thousand miles. It passes from a cold climate, where the hunter obtains his furs and peltries, traverses the temperate latitudes, and discharges its waters into the sea in the region of rice, the cotton plant, and the sugar-cane. From near its mouth at the Balize a steamboat may ascend for 2000 miles with scarcely any perceptible difference in the width of the river. Several of its tributaries, the Red River, the Arkansas, the Missouri, the Ohio, and others, would be regarded elsewhere as of the first importance, and, taken together, are navigable for a distance many times exceeding that of the main stream. No river affords a more striking illustration of the law before mentioned, that an augmentation of volume does not occasion a proportional increase of surface, nay, is even sometimes attended with a narrowing of the channel. The Mississippi is half a mile wide at its junction with the Missouri, the latter being also of equal width; yet the united waters have only, from their confluence to the mouth of the Ohio, a medial width of about half a mile. The junction of the Ohio seems also to produce no increase, but rather a decrease, of surface.356 The St. Francis, White, Arkansas, and Red rivers are also absorbed by the main stream with scarcely any apparent increase of its width, although here and there it expands to a breadth of 1½, or even to 2 miles. On arriving at New Orleans, it is somewhat less than half a mile wide. Its depth there is very variable, the greatest at high water being 168 feet. The mean rate at which the whole body of water flows is variously estimated; according to Mr. Forshey the mean velocity of the current at the surface, somewhat exceeds 2-1/4 miles an hour when the water is at a mean height. For 300 miles above New Orleans the distance measured by the winding river is about twice as great as the distance in a right line. For the first 100 miles from the mouth the rate of fall is 1·80 inch per mile, for the second hundred 2 inches, for the third 2·30, for the fourth 2·57.

Alluvial plain.—The watershed of the Mississippi showcases, on a grand scale, the impact of flowing water across a vast continent. This great river begins nearly at the forty-ninth parallel of north latitude and flows to the Gulf of Mexico at the twenty-ninth—covering a distance, including its twists and turns, of over three thousand miles. It flows from a cold region, where hunters gather furs, through temperate areas, and empties into the sea in a region known for rice, cotton, and sugarcane. From near its mouth at the Balize, a steamboat can travel up the river for 2000 miles with hardly any noticeable change in its width. Several of its tributaries, including the Red River, the Arkansas, the Missouri, and the Ohio, would be considered highly significant elsewhere, and collectively, they are navigable for a distance many times greater than that of the main river. No river better illustrates the previously mentioned principle that an increase in volume does not lead to a proportional increase in width; indeed, it can sometimes result in a narrowing of the channel. The Mississippi is half a mile wide where it meets the Missouri, which is also of similar width; however, from their junction to the mouth of the Ohio, the combined waters have an average width of about half a mile. The joining of the Ohio seems to create no increase in width, but rather a decrease in area.356 The St. Francis, White, Arkansas, and Red rivers are absorbed by the main river with hardly any noticeable widening, though at times it does expand to 1½ or even 2 miles across. When it reaches New Orleans, it's just under half a mile wide. Its depth varies considerably, with the greatest depth at high water reaching 168 feet. The average rate of flow for the entire water body is estimated differently; according to Mr. Forshey, the average surface current speed exceeds 2-1/4 miles per hour when the water is at an average height. For 300 miles upstream from New Orleans, the distance measured along the winding river is about double the straight-line distance. For the first 100 miles from the mouth, the drop rate is 1.80 inches per mile; for the next hundred, it's 2 inches; for the third hundred, 2.30 inches; and for the fourth, 2.57 inches.

The alluvial plain of the Mississippi begins to be of great width below Cape Girardeau, 50 miles above the junction of the Ohio. At this junction it is about 50 miles broad, south of which it contracts to about 30 miles at Memphis, expands again to 80 miles at the mouth of the White River, and then, after various contractions and expansions, protrudes beyond the general coast-line, in a large delta, about 90 miles in width, from N. E. to S. W. Mr. Forshey estimates the area of the great plain as above defined at 31,200 square miles, with a circumference of about 3000 miles, exceeding the area of Ireland. If that part of this plain which lies below, or to the south of the branching off of the highest arm, called the Atchafalaya, be termed the delta, it constitutes less than half of the whole, being 14,000 square British miles in area. The delta may be said to be bounded on the east, west, and 265 south by the sea; on the north chiefly by the broad valley-plain which entirely resembles it in character as in origin. The east and west boundaries of the alluvial region above the head of the delta consists of cliffs or bluffs, which on the east side of the Mississippi are very abrupt, and are undermined by the river at many points. They consist, from Baton Rouge in Louisiana, where they commence, as far north as the borders of Kentucky, of geological formations newer than the cretaceous, the lowest being Eocene, and the uppermost consisting of loam, resembling the loess of the Rhine, and containing freshwater and land shells almost all of existing species. (See fig. 23.) These recent shells are associated with the bones of the mastodon, elephant, tapir, mylodon, horse, ox, and other quadrupeds, most of them of extinct species.

The alluvial plain of the Mississippi starts to widen significantly below Cape Girardeau, 50 miles above where it meets the Ohio River. At that junction, it’s about 50 miles wide, but it narrows to around 30 miles at Memphis, then expands again to 80 miles at the mouth of the White River. After several contractions and expansions, it stretches out beyond the general coastline, forming a large delta approximately 90 miles wide from northeast to southwest. Mr. Forshey estimates the area of this great plain at 31,200 square miles, with a circumference of about 3,000 miles, which is larger than the area of Ireland. If we refer to the part of this plain lying south of the branch of the highest arm, called the Atchafalaya, as the delta, it makes up less than half of the entire area, at 14,000 square British miles. The delta is bounded on the east, west, and south by the sea, and on the north mainly by a broad valley plain that resembles it in both character and origin. The eastern and western boundaries of the alluvial region above the head of the delta consist of cliffs or bluffs, which are quite steep on the east side of the Mississippi and are eroded by the river at many points. These formations, starting from Baton Rouge in Louisiana where they begin, stretch northward to the borders of Kentucky and are made up of geological layers that are newer than the Cretaceous period, with the lowest being Eocene and the uppermost consisting of loam that resembles the loess of the Rhine, containing freshwater and land shells that are mostly of existing species. (See fig. 23.) These recent shells are found alongside the bones of the mastodon, elephant, tapir, mylodon, horse, ox, and other quadrupeds, most of which are extinct species.

I have endeavored to show in my Second Visit to the United States, that this extensive formation of loam is either an ancient alluvial plain or a delta of the great river, formed originally at a lower level, and since upheaved, and partially denuded.

I have tried to demonstrate in my Second Visit to the United States that this large area of loam is either an ancient alluvial plain or a delta of the great river, which was originally formed at a lower level and has since been uplifted and partially eroded.

Fig. 23.
Mississippi Valley.
Modern alluvium of Mississippi.

1. Modern alluvium of Mississippi.   2. Loam or Loess.   3.f. Eocene.   4. Cretaceous.

1. Modern alluvium of the Mississippi.   2. Loam or Loess.   3.f. Eocene.   4. Cretaceous.

The Mississippi in that part of its course which is below the mouth of the Ohio, frequently washes the eastern bluffs, but never once comes in contact with the western. These are composed of similar formations; but I learn from Mr. Forshey that they rise up more gently from the alluvial plain (as at a, fig. 23). It is supposed that the waters are thrown to the eastern side, because all the large tributary rivers entering from the west have filled that side of the great valley with their deltas, or with a sloping mass of clay and sand; so that the opposite bluffs are undermined, and the Mississippi is slowly but incessantly advancing eastward.357

The Mississippi River in that part of its journey below the mouth of the Ohio often washes the eastern bluffs but never touches the western ones. Both sides are made up of similar formations; however, I found out from Mr. Forshey that the western bluffs rise more gradually from the floodplain (as at a, fig. 23). It's believed that the waters are pushed to the eastern side because all the large rivers entering from the west have deposited their sediment in that side of the valley, creating deltas or a sloping mass of clay and sand. This has caused the opposite bluffs to erode, and the Mississippi is slowly but constantly moving eastward.357

Curves of the Mississippi.—The river traverses the plain in a meandering course, describing immense curves. After sweeping round the half of a circle, it is carried in a rapid current diagonally across the ordinary direction of its channel, to another curve of similar shape. Opposite to each of these, there is always a sand-bar, answering, in the convexity of its form, to the concavity of "the bend," as it is called.358 The river, by continually wearing these curves deep, returns, like many other streams before described, on its own track, so that a vessel in some places, after sailing for twenty-five or thirty miles, is brought round again to within a mile of the place whence it started. When the waters approach so near to each other, it often happens at high floods 266 that they burst through the small tongue of land, and insulate a portion, rushing through what is called the "cut-off," so that vessels may pass from one point to another in half a mile to a distance which it previously required a voyage of twenty miles to reach. As soon as the river has excavated the new passage, bars of sand and mud are formed at the two points of junction with the old bend, which is soon entirely separated from the main river by a continuous mud-bank covered with wood. The old bend then becomes a semicircular lake of clear water, inhabited by large gar-fish, alligators, and wild fowl, which the steamboats have nearly driven away from the main river. A multitude of such crescent-shaped lakes, scattered far and wide over the alluvial plain, the greater number of them to the west, but some of them also eastward of the Mississippi, bear testimony of the extensive wanderings of the great stream in former ages. For the last two hundred miles above its mouth the course of the river is much less winding than above, there being only in the whole of that distance one great curve, that called the "English Turn." This great straightness of the stream is ascribed by Mr. Forshey to the superior tenacity of the banks, which are more clayey in this region.

Curves of the Mississippi.—The river flows across the plain in a winding path, making huge curves. After going around half a circle, it quickly moves diagonally to another curve of the same shape. There’s always a sandbar opposite each of these curves, matching the outward curve of the bend. The river constantly erodes these curves, similar to many other rivers, so that in some places a boat, after traveling twenty-five or thirty miles, can end up just a mile away from where it started. When the waters get close together, it often happens during high floods that they break through a small piece of land and isolate a portion, creating a shortcut through what’s called the "cut-off." This allows boats to go from one point to another in half a mile instead of the twenty miles it used to take. Once the river carves out the new path, sand and mud bars form at both junctions with the old bend, which soon gets completely separated from the main river by a continuous mud bank covered in trees. The old bend then becomes a semicircular lake of clear water, home to large garfish, alligators, and wild birds, which the steamboats have nearly driven away from the main river. Numerous crescent-shaped lakes, widely scattered across the alluvial plain—most of them to the west, but some also to the east of the Mississippi—show evidence of the river’s extensive movements in the past. For the last two hundred miles before its mouth, the river is much straighter than upstream, with only one major curve, known as the "English Turn." Mr. Forshey attributes this straightness to the stronger banks, which are more clay-rich in this area.

Fig. 24.

Fig. 24.

Section of channel, bank, levees.

Section of channel, bank, levees (a and b), and swamps of Mississippi river.

Section of channel, bank, levees (a and b), and swamps of the Mississippi River.

The Mississippi has been incorrectly described by some of the earlier geographers, as a river running along the top of a long hill, or mound in a plain. In reality it runs in a valley, from 100 to 200 or more feet in depth, as a, c, b, fig. 24, its banks forming long strips of land parallel to the course of the main stream, and to the swamps g, f, and d, e, lying on each side. These extensive morasses, which are commonly well-wooded, though often submerged for months continuously, are rarely more than fifteen feet below the summit level of the banks. The banks themselves are occasionally overflowed, but are usually above water for a breadth of about two miles. They follow all the curves of the great river, and near New Orleans are raised artificially by embankments (or levees), a b, fig. 24, through which the river when swollen sometimes cuts a deep channel (or crevasse), inundating the adjoining low lands and swamps, and not sparing the lower streets of the great city.

The Mississippi has been inaccurately described by some early geographers as a river running along the top of a long hill or mound in a flat area. In reality, it flows through a valley that is 100 to 200 or more feet deep, as a, c, b, fig. 24, with its banks creating long strips of land parallel to the course of the main stream and to the swamps g, f, and d, e, that lie on either side. These large marshes, which are often well-wooded but can be submerged for months at a time, are typically no more than fifteen feet below the top level of the banks. The banks themselves sometimes overflow, but they are usually above water for about two miles. They follow all the curves of the great river, and near New Orleans, they are artificially raised by embankments (or levees), a b, fig. 24, which the river can sometimes breach during floods, cutting deep channels (or crevasses) that inundate the nearby lowlands and swamps, affecting even the lower streets of the great city.

The cause of the uniform upward slope of the river-bank above the adjoining alluvial plain is this: when the waters charged with sediment pass over the banks in the flood season, their velocity is checked among the herbage and reeds, and they throw down at once the coarser and more sandy matter with which they are charged. But the fine particles of mud are carried farther on, so that at the distance of about two 267 miles, a thin film of fine clay only subsides, forming a stiff unctuous black soil, which gradually envelops the base of trees growing on the borders of the swamps.

The reason for the steady upward slope of the riverbank above the neighboring floodplain is this: when waters full of sediment overflow the banks during the flood season, their speed slows down among the plants and reeds, causing them to drop the heavier, sandier materials they carry. However, the finer mud particles are carried further away, resulting in a thin layer of fine clay settling about two 267 miles away, creating a dense, slippery black soil that gradually covers the roots of trees growing along the edges of the swamps.

Waste of the banks.—It has been said of a mountain torrent, that "it lays down what it will remove, and removes what it has laid down;" and in like manner the Mississippi, by the continual shifting of its course, sweeps away, during a great portion of the year, considerable tracts of alluvium, which were gradually accumulated by the overflow of former years, and the matter now left during the spring-floods will be at some future time removed. After the flood season, when the river subsides within its channel, it acts with destructive force upon the alluvial banks, softened and diluted by the recent overflow. Several acres at a time, thickly covered with wood, are precipitated into the stream; and large portions of the islands are frequently swept away.

Waste of the banks.—It has been said of a mountain torrent that "it leaves behind what it will take away and takes away what it has left behind;" and similarly, the Mississippi, with its constantly changing course, washes away, for a large part of the year, significant areas of alluvium that have gradually built up through previous floods. The debris left behind during the spring floods will eventually be washed away. After the flood season, when the river levels drop back into their channels, it exerts destructive force on the alluvial banks, which have been softened and diluted by the recent overflow. Several acres at a time, densely covered with trees, are swept into the water; and large parts of the islands are often carried away.

"Some years ago," observes Captain Hall, "when the Mississippi was regularly surveyed, all its islands were numbered, from the confluence of the Missouri to the sea; but every season makes such revolutions, not only in the number, but in the magnitude and situation of these islands, that this enumeration is now almost obsolete. Sometimes large islands are entirely melted away; at other places they have attached themselves to the main shore, or, which is the more correct statement, the interval has been filled up by myriads of logs cemented together by mud and rubbish."359

"Years ago," says Captain Hall, "when the Mississippi was regularly surveyed, all its islands were numbered from the junction of the Missouri to the sea; but every season brings such changes, not just in the number but in the size and location of these islands, that this count is now almost outdated. Sometimes, large islands completely disappear; in other places, they merge with the main shore, or, more accurately, the gaps have been filled in by countless logs stuck together with mud and debris."359

Rafts.—One of the most interesting features in the great rivers of this part of America is the frequent accumulation of what are termed "rafts," or masses of floating trees, which have been arrested in their progress by snags, islands, shoals, or other obstructions, and made to accumulate, so as to form natural bridges, reaching entirely across the stream. One of the largest of these was called the raft of the Atchafalaya, an arm of the Mississippi, which was certainly at some former time the channel of the Red River, when the latter found its way to the Gulf of Mexico by a separate course. The Atchafalaya being in a direct line with the general direction of the Mississippi, catches a large portion of the timber annually brought down from the north; and the drift-trees collected in about thirty-eight years previous to 1816 formed a continuous raft, no less than ten miles in length, 220 yards wide, and eight feet deep. The whole rose and fell with the water, yet was covered with green bushes and trees, and its surface enlivened in the autumn by a variety of beautiful flowers. It went on increasing till about 1835, when some of the trees upon it had grown to the height of about sixty feet. Steps were then taken by the State of Louisiana to clear away the whole raft, and open the navigation, which was effected, not without great labor, in the space of four years.

Rafts.—One of the most fascinating features of the major rivers in this part of America is the frequent buildup of what are known as "rafts," or collections of floating trees that have been stopped in their flow by snags, islands, shoals, or other obstacles, leading to the formation of natural bridges that stretch completely across the river. One of the largest of these was called the raft of the Atchafalaya, which is an arm of the Mississippi and was once likely the channel of the Red River when the latter flowed to the Gulf of Mexico via a different route. Since the Atchafalaya runs directly in line with the general direction of the Mississippi, it captures a large amount of timber that is brought downstream from the north each year; the driftwood that collected about thirty-eight years before 1816 created a continuous raft that was no less than ten miles long, 220 yards wide, and eight feet deep. It rose and fell with the water but was covered in green bushes and trees, with its surface blooming in the fall with a variety of beautiful flowers. It continued to grow until around 1835, when some of the trees on it reached heights of about sixty feet. The State of Louisiana then took action to clear the entire raft and open up navigation, which was accomplished, though not without significant effort, over the course of four years.

The rafts on Red River are equally remarkable: in some parts of its course, cedar-trees are heaped up by themselves, and in other places, 268 pines. On the rise of the waters in summer hundreds of these are seen, some with their green leaves still upon them, just as they have fallen from a neighboring bank, others leafless, broken and worn in their passage from a far distant tributary: wherever they accumulate on the edge of a sand-bar they arrest the current, and soon become covered with sediment. On this mud the young willows and the poplars called cotton-wood spring up, their boughs still farther retarding the stream, and as the inundation rises, accelerating the deposition of new soil. The bank continuing to enlarge, the channel at length becomes so narrow that a single long tree may reach from side to side, and the remaining space is then soon choked up by a quantity of other timber.

The rafts on Red River are impressive: in some stretches, you can find piles of cedar trees, while in others, there are pines. When the waters rise in summer, hundreds of these trees are visible, some still with their green leaves as they fell from a nearby bank, while others are leafless, broken, and worn from their journey from a distant tributary. Wherever they collect on the edge of a sandbar, they slow down the current and soon get covered with sediment. On this mud, young willows and cottonwoods sprout, their branches further slowing the flow of the stream, which helps increase the deposition of new soil as the flood rises. As the bank continues to grow, the channel eventually becomes so narrow that a single long tree can stretch from one side to the other, and the remaining space quickly fills up with more timber.

"Unfortunately for the navigation of the Mississippi," observes Captain Hall, "some of the largest trunks, after being cast down from the position on which they grew, get their roots entangled with the bottom of the river, where they remain anchored, as it were, in the mud. The force of the current naturally gives their tops a tendency downwards, and, by its flowing past, soon strips them of their leaves and branches. These fixtures, called snags, or planters, are extremely dangerous to the steam-vessels proceeding up the stream, in which they lie like a lance in rest, concealed beneath the water, with their sharp ends pointed directly against the bows of the vessels coming up. For the most part these formidable snags remain so still that they can be detected only by a slight ripple above them, not perceptible to inexperienced eyes. Sometimes, however, they vibrate up and down, alternately showing their heads above the surface and bathing them beneath it."360 So imminent, until lately, was the danger caused by these obstructions, that almost all the boats on the Mississippi were constructed on a particular plan, to guard against fatal accidents; but in the last ten years, by the aid of the power of steam and the machinery of a snag-boat, as it is called, the greater number of these trunks of trees have been drawn out of the mud.361

"Unfortunately for navigating the Mississippi," Captain Hall notes, "some of the largest tree trunks, after falling from their original spots, get their roots tangled in the riverbed, where they remain anchored in the mud. The current naturally pulls their tops downwards, and as it flows past, it quickly strips them of their leaves and branches. These hazards, known as snags or planters, are extremely dangerous for steam vessels traveling upstream, lying like a lance at rest, hidden beneath the water, with their sharp ends pointed directly at the bows of the incoming vessels. Most of the time, these formidable snags stay so still that they can only be spotted by a slight ripple above them, which inexperienced observers might miss. Sometimes, however, they move up and down, alternately revealing their heads above the surface and then dipping back under." 360 "Until recently, the danger posed by these obstructions was so severe that almost all the boats on the Mississippi were built according to a specific design to prevent fatal accidents; but in the last ten years, thanks to steam power and the machinery of a snag-boat, many of these tree trunks have been pulled out of the mud." 361

The prodigious quantity of wood annually drifted down by the Mississippi and its tributaries, is a subject of geological interest, not merely as illustrating the manner in which abundance of vegetable matter becomes, in the ordinary course of nature, imbedded in submarine and estuary deposits, but as attesting the constant destruction of soil and transportation of matter to lower levels by the tendency of rivers to shift their courses. Each of these trees must have required many years, some of them centuries, to attain their full size; the soil, therefore, whereon they grew, after remaining undisturbed for long periods, is ultimately torn up and swept away.

The huge amount of wood that drifts down the Mississippi and its tributaries each year is fascinating from a geological perspective. It not only shows how large quantities of plant material become buried in underwater and estuary deposits through natural processes, but it also demonstrates how constant soil erosion and river shifts transport material to lower areas. Each of these trees must have taken many years—some even centuries—to reach their full size; therefore, the soil where they grew, after being undisturbed for long periods, is eventually uprooted and carried away.

269 It is also found in excavating at New Orleans, even at the depth of several yards below the level of the sea, that the soil of the delta contains innumerable trunks of trees, layer above layer, some prostrate, as if drifted, others broken off near the bottom, but remaining still erect, and with their roots spreading on all sides, as if in their natural position. In such situations they appeared to me to indicate a sinking of the ground, as the trees must formerly have grown in marshes above the sea-level. In the higher parts of the alluvial plain, for many hundred miles above the head of the delta, similar stools and roots of trees are also seen buried in stiff clay at different levels, one above the other, and exposed to view in the banks at low water. They point clearly to the successive growth of forests in the extensive swamps of the plain, where the ground was slowly raised, year after year, by the mud thrown down during inundations. These roots and stools belong chiefly to the deciduous cypress (Taxodium distichum), and other swamp-trees, and they bear testimony to the constant shifting of the course of the great river, which is always excavating land originally formed at some distance from its banks.

269 In digging at New Orleans, even several yards below sea level, the delta soil contains countless tree trunks layered on top of one another—some lying down as if washed away, and others snapped off near the base but still standing, with their roots spreading out in all directions, as if they were still in their natural position. To me, this suggests that the ground is sinking, as the trees must have originally grown in marshes above sea level. In the higher regions of the alluvial plain, many hundreds of miles above the delta's head, similar tree stumps and roots can also be found buried in hard clay at various levels, stacked one over the other, and visible along the banks at low water. They clearly indicate the successive growth of forests in the vast swamps of the plain, where the ground was gradually raised each year by the mud deposited during floods. These roots and stumps mainly belong to the deciduous cypress (Taxodium distichum) and other swamp trees, and they highlight the ongoing changes in the course of the great river, which constantly carves out land that was once located farther from its banks.

Formation of lakes in Louisiana..—Another striking feature in the basin of the Mississippi, illustrative of the changes now in progress, is the formation by natural causes of great lakes, and the drainage of others. These are especially frequent in the basin of the Red River in Louisiana, where the largest of them, called Bistineau, is more than thirty miles long, and has a medium depth of from fifteen to twenty feet. In the deepest parts are seen numerous cypress-trees, of all sizes, now dead, and most of them with their tops broken by the wind, yet standing erect under water. This tree resists the action of air and water longer than any other, and, if not submerged throughout the whole year, will retain life for an extraordinary period. Lake Bistineau, as well as Black Lake, Cado Lake, Spanish Lake, Natchitoches Lake, and many others, have been formed, according to Darby, by the gradual elevation of the bed of Red River, in which the alluvial accumulations have been so great as to raise its channel, and cause its waters, during the flood season, to flow up the mouths of many tributaries, and to convert parts of their courses into lakes. In the autumn, when the level of Red River is again depressed, the waters rush back, and some lakes become grassy meadows, with streams meandering through them.362 Thus, there is a periodical flux and reflux between Red River and some of these basins, which are merely reservoirs, alternately emptied and filled, like our tide estuaries—with this difference, that in the one case the land is submerged for several months continuously, and in the other twice in every twenty-four hours. It has happened, in several cases, that a raft of timber or a bar has been thrown by Red River across some of the openings of these channels, and then the lakes become, like Bistineau, constant repositories of water. But, even in these cases, their level is liable to annual elevation 270 and depression, because the flood of the main river, when at its height, passes over the bar; just as, where sand-hills close the entrance of an estuary on the Norfolk or Suffolk coast, the sea, during some high tide or storm, has often breached the barrier and inundated again the interior.

Formation of lakes in Louisiana.—Another striking feature in the basin of the Mississippi, highlighting the ongoing changes, is the natural formation of large lakes and the drainage of others. This is especially common in the Red River basin in Louisiana, where the largest lake, called Bistineau, is over thirty miles long and has an average depth of fifteen to twenty feet. In the deepest areas, there are many cypress trees of various sizes, now dead, most with their tops broken by the wind, yet still standing upright underwater. This tree endures exposure to air and water longer than any other, and if it isn't submerged for the entire year, it can stay alive for an incredible amount of time. Lake Bistineau, along with Black Lake, Cado Lake, Spanish Lake, Natchitoches Lake, and many others, has been created, according to Darby, by the gradual raising of the Red River bed, where significant alluvial deposits have raised its channel and caused its waters, during flood season, to flow into the mouths of many tributaries, turning parts of their paths into lakes. In the autumn, when the Red River level lowers again, the waters rush back, and some lakes transform into grassy meadows, with streams winding through them.362 Therefore, there is a periodic ebb and flow between the Red River and some of these basins, which act as reservoirs, alternately emptying and filling, similar to our tidal estuaries—with the key difference that in one case, the land is submerged for several continuous months, while in the other, it is twice every twenty-four hours. In several instances, a raft of timber or a sandbar has been pushed by the Red River across some openings in these channels, causing the lakes to become, like Bistineau, permanent bodies of water. However, even in these instances, their levels are subject to annual rises and falls because the flood from the main river, at its peak, can overflow the bar; just like how, where sand hills close an estuary’s entrance on the Norfolk or Suffolk coast, the sea, during high tides or storms, has often broken through the barrier and flooded the interior.

I am informed by Mr. Featherstonhaugh that the plains of the Red River and the Arkansas are so low and flat, that whenever the Mississippi rises thirty feet above its ordinary level, those great tributaries are made to flow back, and inundate a region of vast extent. Both the streams alluded to contain red sediment, derived from the decomposition of red porphyry; and since 1833, when there was a great inundation in the Arkansas, an immense swamp has been formed near the Mammelle mountain, comprising 30,000 acres, with here and there large lagoons, where the old bed of the river was situated; in which innumerable trees, for the most part dead, are seen standing, of cypress, cotton-wood, or poplar, the triple-thorned acacia, and others, which are of great size. Their trunks appear as if painted red for about fifteen feet from the ground; at which height a perfectly level line extends through the whole forest, marking the rise of the waters during the last flood.363

I'm informed by Mr. Featherstonhaugh that the plains of the Red River and the Arkansas are so low and flat that whenever the Mississippi rises thirty feet above its usual level, those major tributaries end up flowing backward, flooding a vast area. Both rivers mentioned have red sediment from the breakdown of red porphyry, and since 1833, when there was a major flood in the Arkansas, an enormous swamp has formed near Mammelle Mountain, covering 30,000 acres, with large lagoons scattered throughout where the old riverbed used to be. Here, countless trees, mostly dead, stand tall, including cypress, cottonwood, poplar, triple-thorned acacia, and others that are quite large. Their trunks look like they've been painted red for about fifteen feet up from the ground; at that height, a perfectly straight line runs through the entire forest, marking how high the water rose during the last flood.363

But most probably the causes above assigned for the recent origin of these lakes are not the only ones. Subterranean movements have altered, so lately as the years 1811-12, the relative levels of various parts of the basin of the Mississippi, situated 300 miles northeast of Lake Bistineau. In those years the great valley, from the mouth of the Ohio to that of the St. Francis, including a tract 300 miles in length, and exceeding in area the whole basin of the Thames, was convulsed to such a degree, as to create new islands in the river, and lakes in the alluvial plain. Some of these were on the left or east bank of the Mississippi, and were twenty miles in extent; as, for example, those named Reelfoot and Obion in Tennessee, formed in the channels or valleys of small streams bearing the same names.364

But it's likely that the reasons given for the recent formation of these lakes aren't the only ones. Underground movements have changed, as recently as the years 1811-12, the relative levels of different parts of the Mississippi basin, located 300 miles northeast of Lake Bistineau. During those years, the vast valley from the mouth of the Ohio to that of the St. Francis, spanning 300 miles in length and covering more area than the entire Thames basin, was shaken to such an extent that new islands formed in the river, and lakes emerged in the floodplain. Some of these were on the left or east bank of the Mississippi and were twenty miles wide; for example, those called Reelfoot and Obion in Tennessee, created in the channels or valleys of small streams that share the same names.364

But the largest area affected by the great convulsion lies eight or ten miles to the westward of the Mississippi, and inland from the town of New Madrid, in Missouri. It is called "the sunk country," and is said 271 to extend along the course of the White Water and its tributaries, for a distance of between seventy and eighty miles north and south, and thirty miles or more east and west. Throughout this area, innumerable submerged trees, some standing leafless, others prostrate, are seen; and so great is the extent of lake and marsh, that an active trade in the skins of muskrats, mink, otters, and other wild animals, is now carried on there. In March, 1846, I skirted the borders of the "sunk country" nearest to New Madrid, passing along the Bayou St. John and Little Prairie, where dead trees of various kinds, some erect in the water, others fallen, and strewed in dense masses over the bottom, in the shallows, and near the shore, were conspicuous. I also beheld countless rents in the adjoining dry alluvial plains, caused by the movements of the soil in 1811-12, and still open, though the rains, frost, and river inundations, have greatly diminished their original depth. I observed, moreover, numerous circular cavities, called "sunk holes," from ten to thirty yards wide, and twenty feet or more in depth, which interrupt the general level of the plain. These were formed by the spouting out of large quantities of sand and mud during the earthquakes.365

But the largest area impacted by the major upheaval is located eight or ten miles west of the Mississippi, inland from the town of New Madrid, Missouri. It's referred to as "the sunk country," and is said to stretch along the White Water and its tributaries for about seventy to eighty miles north and south, and over thirty miles east and west. Throughout this region, there are countless submerged trees, some standing leafless while others are fallen, and the expanse of lakes and marshes is so vast that there is now an active trade in muskrat, mink, otter, and other wild animal skins. In March 1846, I traveled along the borders of the "sunk country" closest to New Madrid, passing by Bayou St. John and Little Prairie, where dead trees of various types were noticeable—some upright in the water, others fallen, and piled in dense clusters on the bottom, in shallow areas, and near the shore. I also saw numerous cracks in the adjacent dry alluvial plains, caused by the soil movements in 1811-12, which are still visible, although rain, frost, and river flooding have significantly reduced their original depth. Additionally, I noted many circular depressions, called "sunk holes," ranging from ten to thirty yards wide and over twenty feet deep, disrupting the overall flatness of the plain. These were created by the eruption of large amounts of sand and mud during the earthquakes.365

That the prevailing changes of level in the delta and alluvial plain of the Mississippi have been caused by the subsidence, rather than the upheaval of land, appears to me established by the fact, that there are no protuberances of upraised alluvial soil, projecting above the level surface of the great plain. It is true that the gradual elevation of that plain, by new accessions of matter, would tend to efface every inequality derived from this source, but we might certainly have expected to find more broken ground between the opposite bluffs, had local upthrows of alluvial strata been of repeated occurrence.

The changes in elevation in the delta and alluvial plain of the Mississippi are caused by subsidence rather than land uplift. This is evident because there are no raised areas of alluvial soil sticking up above the flat surface of the plain. While the gradual rise of the plain due to new deposits would smooth out any irregularities from this process, we would expect to see more uneven terrain between the bluffs if there had been repeated local uplift of the alluvial layers.

Antiquity of the delta.—The vast size of the alluvial plain both above and below the head of the delta, or the branching off of the uppermost arm of the Atchafalaya, has been already alluded to. Its superficial dimensions, according to Mr. Forshey, exceed 30,000 square miles, nearly half of which belong to the true delta. The deposits consist partly of sand originally formed upon or near the banks of the river, and its tributaries, partly of gravel, swept down the main channel, of which the position has continually shifted, and partly of fine mud slowly accumulated in the swamps. The farther we descend the river towards its mouth, the finer becomes the texture of the sediment. The whole alluvial formation, from the base of the delta upwards, slopes with a very gentle inclination, rising about three inches in a mile from the level of the sea at the Balize, to the height of about 200 feet in a distance of about 800 miles.

Antiquity of the delta.—The enormous size of the alluvial plain both above and below the head of the delta, or the splitting off of the uppermost arm of the Atchafalaya, has already been mentioned. Its surface area, according to Mr. Forshey, is over 30,000 square miles, almost half of which is part of the true delta. The deposits consist partly of sand that was originally formed on or near the banks of the river and its tributaries, partly of gravel carried down the main channel, the position of which has continuously shifted, and partly of fine mud that has slowly built up in the swamps. The further we travel down the river towards its mouth, the finer the texture of the sediment becomes. The entire alluvial formation, from the base of the delta upwards, slopes very gently, rising about three inches per mile from sea level at the Balize to a height of around 200 feet over a distance of about 800 miles.

That a large portion of this fluviatile deposit, together with the fluvio-marine strata now in progress near the Balize, consists of mud and sand with much vegetable matter intermixed, may be inferred from what has 272 been said of the abundance of drift trees floated down every summer. These are seen matted together into a net-work around the extensive mud banks at the extreme mouths of the river. Every one acquainted with the geography of Louisiana is aware that the most southern part of the delta forms a long narrow tongue of land protruding for 50 miles into the Gulf of Mexico, at the end of which are numerous channels of discharge. This singular promontory consists simply of the river and its two low, flat banks, covered with reeds, young willows, and poplars. Its appearance answers precisely to that of the banks far in the interior, when nothing appears above water during inundations but the higher part of the sloping glacis or bank. In the one case we have the swamps or an expanse of freshwater with the tops of trees appearing above, in the other the bluish green surface of the Gulf of Mexico. An opinion has very commonly prevailed that this narrow promontory, the newest product of the river, has gained very rapidly upon the sea, since the foundation of New Orleans; but after visiting the Balize in 1846, in company with Dr. Carpenter, and making many inquiries of the pilots, and comparing the present outline of the coast with the excellent Spanish chart, published by Charlevoix 120 years before, we came to a different conclusion. The rate of permanent advance of the new land has been very slow, not exceeding perhaps one mile in a century. The gain may have been somewhat more rapid in former years, when the new strip of soil projected less far into the gulf, since it is now much more exposed to the action of a strong marine current. The tides also, when the waters of the river are low, enter into each opening, and scour them out, destroying the banks of mud and the sand-bars newly formed during the flood season.

A large part of this river deposit, along with the fluvio-marine layers currently forming near the Balize, is made up of mud and sand combined with a lot of plant material. This can be inferred from the many driftwood trees that get swept down every summer. These trees get tangled together into a network around the large mud banks at the river's mouth. Anyone familiar with Louisiana's geography knows that the southernmost part of the delta forms a long, narrow piece of land that extends about 50 miles into the Gulf of Mexico, where there are many outlet channels. This unique landmass consists solely of the river and its two low, flat banks, which are covered with reeds, young willows, and poplars. It looks just like the interior banks, where, during floods, only the higher parts of the sloping banks are visible. In one case, we see swamps or a stretch of freshwater with the tops of trees showing above, and in the other, the bluish-green surface of the Gulf of Mexico. There has been a common belief that this narrow landform, the newest product of the river, has rapidly encroached upon the sea since New Orleans was established. However, after visiting Balize in 1846 with Dr. Carpenter and asking many questions of the pilots, as well as comparing the current coastline with an excellent Spanish chart published by Charlevoix 120 years earlier, we reached a different conclusion. The actual rate of the new land's permanent advance has been quite slow, probably not exceeding one mile per century. The gain may have been a bit faster in the past when the new land jutted less far into the gulf, as it is now more exposed to strong ocean currents. Additionally, tides, when the river water is low, flow into each opening and erode them, washing away the mud banks and newly formed sandbars from the flood season.

An observation of Darby, in regard to the strata composing part of this delta, deserves attention. In the steep banks of the Atchafalaya, before alluded to, the following section, he says, is observable at low water:—first an upper stratum, consisting invariably of bluish clay, common to the banks of the Mississippi; below this a stratum of red ochreous earth, peculiar to Red River, under which the blue clay of the Mississippi again appears; and this arrangement is constant, proving, as that geographer remarks, that the waters of the Mississippi and the Red River occupied alternately, at some former periods, considerable tracts below their present point of union.366 Such alternations are probably common in submarine spaces situated between two converging deltas; for, before the two rivers unite, there must almost always be a certain period when an intermediate tract will by turns be occupied and abandoned by the waters of each stream; since it can rarely happen that the season of highest flood will precisely correspond in each. In the case of the Red River and Mississippi, which carry off the waters from countries placed under widely distant latitudes, an exact coincidence in the time of greatest inundation is very improbable.

An observation by Darby about the layers making up part of this delta is worth noting. In the steep banks of the Atchafalaya, mentioned earlier, he points out the following section that can be seen at low water: first, there’s an upper layer that is consistently blue clay, which is common to the Mississippi banks; below this is a layer of red ochre soil, specific to the Red River, and beneath that, the blue clay from the Mississippi reappears. This arrangement is consistent, demonstrating, as that geographer mentions, that the waters of the Mississippi and the Red River alternately occupied significant areas below their current point of convergence at some past times. Such alternations are likely common in underwater areas located between two converging deltas; before the two rivers merge, there will almost always be a period when an intermediate area is alternately occupied and abandoned by the waters from each river, since it’s unlikely that the season of highest flooding will perfectly align for both. In the case of the Red River and the Mississippi, which drain waters from regions at widely different latitudes, it's very unlikely for the times of greatest flooding to coincide exactly.

273 The antiquity of the delta, or length of the period which has been occupied in the deposition of so vast a mass of alluvial matter, is a question which may well excite the curiosity of every geologist. Sufficient data have not yet been obtained to afford a full and satisfactory answer to the inquiry, but some approximation may already be made to the minimum of time required.

273 The age of the delta, or how long it’s taken to accumulate such a large amount of sediment, is a topic that surely piques the interest of every geologist. There isn't enough information yet to provide a complete and satisfying answer to this question, but we can start to estimate the minimum time needed.

When I visited New Orleans, in February, 1846, I found that Dr. Riddell had made numerous experiments to ascertain the proportion of sediment contained in the waters of the Mississippi; and he concluded that the mean annual amount of solid matter was to the water as 1/1245 in weight, or about 1/3000 in volume.367 From the observations of the same gentleman, and those of Dr. Carpenter and Mr. Forshey, an eminent engineer, to whom I have before alluded, the average width, depth, and velocity of the Mississippi, and thence the mean annual discharge of water were deduced. I assumed 528 feet, or the tenth of a mile, as the probable thickness of the deposit of mud and sand in the delta; founding my conjecture chiefly on the depth of the Gulf of Mexico, between the southern point of Florida and the Balize, which equals on an average 100 fathoms, and partly on some borings 600 feet deep in the delta, near Lake Pontchartrain, north of New Orleans, in which the bottom of the alluvial matter is said not to have been reached. The area of the delta being about 13,600 square statute miles, and the quantity of solid matter annually brought down by the river 3,702,758,400 cubic feet, it must have taken 67,000 years for the formation of the whole; and if the alluvial matter of the plain above be 264 feet deep, or half that of the delta,368 it must have required 33,500 more years for its accumulation, even if its area be estimated as only equal to that of the delta, whereas it is in fact larger. If some deduction be made from the time here stated, in consequence of the effect of the drift-wood, which must have aided in filling up more rapidly the space above alluded to, a far more important allowance must be made on the other hand, for the loss of matter, owing to the finer particles of mud 274 not settling at the mouths of the river, but being swept out far to sea during the predominant action of the tides, and the waves in the winter months, when the current of fresh water is feeble. Yet however vast the time during which the Mississippi has been transporting its earthy burden to the ocean, the whole period, though far exceeding, perhaps, 100,000 years, must be insignificant in a geological point of view, since the bluffs or cliffs, bounding the great valley, and therefore older in date, and which are from 50 to 250 feet in perpendicular height, consist in great part of loam containing land, fluviatile, and lacustrine shells of species still inhabiting the same country. (See fig. 23, p. 265.)

When I visited New Orleans in February 1846, I discovered that Dr. Riddell had conducted many experiments to determine the amount of sediment in the waters of the Mississippi. He concluded that the average annual concentration of solid matter was about 1/1245 by weight or roughly 1/3000 by volume.367 Based on observations from Dr. Riddell, along with Dr. Carpenter and Mr. Forshey, a notable engineer I mentioned earlier, they calculated the average width, depth, and velocity of the Mississippi and, in turn, the mean annual water discharge. I estimated the thickness of the mud and sand deposit in the delta to be around 528 feet, or one-tenth of a mile. This was primarily based on the depth of the Gulf of Mexico between the southern tip of Florida and the Balize, which averages 100 fathoms, and partly on some borings that went 600 feet deep in the delta, near Lake Pontchartrain, north of New Orleans, where they claim the bottom of the alluvial matter hasn't been reached. The delta covers about 13,600 square statute miles, and the amount of solid matter the river delivers each year is 3,702,758,400 cubic feet, suggesting it took about 67,000 years for the whole area to form. If the alluvial matter above is 264 feet deep, or half that of the delta,368 it would have required another 33,500 years for its accumulation, even if its area is assumed to be the same as the delta, although it's actually larger. If we deduct some time here due to driftwood helping to fill the space faster, we still need to consider the loss of material, as finer mud particles do not settle at the river's mouth; instead, they are carried far out to sea during strong tidal actions and winter waves when the fresh water current is weak. Yet, despite the immense time over which the Mississippi has been transporting its earth to the ocean, the entire period, though likely surpassing 100,000 years, is trivial from a geological perspective, since the bluffs or cliffs surrounding the great valley, which are older and range from 50 to 250 feet in height, are largely composed of loam containing land, river, and lake shells from species still found in the area. (See fig. 23, p. 265.)

Before we take leave of the great delta, we may derive an instructive lesson from the reflection that the new deposits already formed, or now accumulating, whether marine or freshwater, must greatly resemble in composition, and the general character of their organic remains, many ancient strata, which enter largely into the earth's structure. Yet there is no sudden revolution in progress, whether on the land or in the waters, whether in the animate or the inanimate world. Notwithstanding the excessive destruction of soil and uprooting of trees, the region which yields a never-failing supply of drift-wood is densely clothed with noble forests, and is almost unrivalled in its power of supporting animal and vegetable life. In spite of the undermining of many a lofty bluff, and the encroachments of the delta on the sea—in spite of the earthquake, which rends and fissures the soil, or causes areas more than sixty miles in length to sink down several yards in a few months, the general features of the district remain unaltered, or are merely undergoing a slow and insensible change. Herds of wild deer graze on the pastures, or browse upon the trees; and if they diminish in number, it is only where they give way to man and the domestic animals which follow in his train. The bear, the wolf, the fox, the panther, and the wild-cat, still maintain themselves in the fastnesses of the forests of cypress and gum-tree. The racoon and the opossum are everywhere abundant, while the musk-rat, otter, and mink still frequent the rivers and lakes, and a few beavers and buffaloes have not yet been driven from their ancient haunts. The waters teem with aligators, tortoises, and fish, and their surface is covered with millions of migratory waterfowl, which perform their annual voyage between the Canadian lakes and the shores of the Mexican Gulf. The power of man begins to be sensibly felt, and many parts of the wilderness to be replaced by towns, orchards, and gardens. The gilded steamboats, like moving palaces, stem the force of the current, or shoot rapidly down the descending stream, through the solitudes of the forests and prairies. Already does the flourishing population of the great valley far exceed that of the thirteen United States when first they declared their independence. Such is the state of a continent where trees and stones are hurried annually by a thousand torrents, from the mountains to the plains, and where sand and finer matter are swept down by a vast current to the sea, together with the wreck of countless forests and the 275 bones of animals which perish in the inundations. When these materials reach the gulf, they do not render the waters unfit for aquatic animals; but on the contrary, the ocean here swarms with life, as it generally does where the influx of a great river furnishes a copious supply of organic and mineral matter. Yet many geologists, when they behold the spoils of the land heaped in successive strata, and blended confusedly with the remains of fishes, or interspersed with broken shells and corals; when they see portions of erect trunks of trees with their roots still retaining their natural position, and one tier of these preserved in a fossil state above another, imagine that they are viewing the signs of a turbulent instead of a tranquil and settled state of the planet. They read in such phenomena the proof of chaotic disorder and reiterated catastrophes, instead of indications of a surface as habitable as the most delicious and fertile districts now tenanted by man.

Before we leave the great delta, we can take an important lesson from the fact that the new deposits forming now, whether from marine or freshwater sources, must closely resemble many ancient layers that make up the Earth's structure in terms of composition and the type of organic remains. Yet, there is no sudden transformation happening, whether on land or in water, in the living or non-living world. Despite the excessive soil destruction and tree uprooting, the area that provides a constant supply of driftwood is richly covered with magnificent forests and is almost unmatched in its ability to support animal and plant life. Despite the erosion of many high bluffs and the delta's encroachment on the sea—along with earthquakes that tear and crack the ground or cause areas over sixty miles long to sink several yards in just a few months—the general characteristics of the region remain unchanged or are only gradually undergoing slow and imperceptible transformations. Herds of wild deer graze in the fields or feed on the trees; if their numbers decrease, it's only where they yield to humans and the domestic animals that accompany them. Bears, wolves, foxes, panthers, and wildcats still thrive in the dense forests of cypress and gum trees. Raccoons and opossums are abundant everywhere, while muskrats, otters, and minks still frequent the rivers and lakes, and a few beavers and buffaloes have not yet been driven from their traditional habitats. The waters are full of alligators, turtles, and fish, and the surface is covered with millions of migratory waterfowl that make their annual journey between the Canadian lakes and the shores of the Gulf of Mexico. The influence of humans is becoming noticeably stronger, as many parts of the wilderness are replaced by towns, orchards, and gardens. Gilded steamboats, like moving palaces, navigate against the current or rush swiftly down the river through the solitude of forests and prairies. The thriving population of the great valley already far surpasses that of the thirteen United States when they first declared their independence. This is the state of a continent where trees and stones are swept annually by numerous torrents from the mountains to the plains, and where sand and finer materials are carried down by a huge current to the sea, alongside the remains of countless forests and the 275 bones of animals lost in the floods. When these materials reach the gulf, they do not make the waters unsuitable for aquatic life; instead, the ocean here is teeming with life, as it usually is where the inflow of a large river provides a rich supply of organic and mineral materials. Yet many geologists, when they see the land's rubble piled in successive layers, mixed with fish remains or scattered with broken shells and corals; when they observe sections of upright tree trunks still with their roots in place, and one layer of these preserved in a fossil state above another, mistakenly think they are witnessing signs of chaotic upheaval rather than a calm and stable planet. They interpret such phenomena as evidence of chaotic disorder and repeated disasters, rather than indications of a surface as livable as the most delightful and fertile areas now inhabited by people.

Fig. 25.

Fig. 25.

Map of the Delta of the Ganges.

Map of the Delta of the Ganges and Brahmapootra.

Map of the Ganges and Brahmaputra Delta.

As an example of a still larger delta advancing upon the sea in opposition to more powerful tides, I shall next describe that of the Ganges and Brahmapootra (or Burrampooter). These, the two principal rivers of India, descend from the highest mountains in the world, and partially mingle their waters in the low plains of Hindostan, before reaching the head of the Bay of Bengal. The Brahmapootra, somewhat the larger of the two, formerly passed to the east of Dacca, even so lately as the beginning of the present century, pouring most of its waters into one of the numerous channels in the delta called "the Megna." By 276 that name the main stream was always spoken of by Rennell and others in their memoirs on this region. But the main trunk now unites with an arm of the Ganges considerably higher up, at a point about 100 miles distant from the sea; and it is constantly, according to Dr. Hooker, working its way westward, having formerly, as may be seen by ancient maps, moved eastward for a long period.

As an example of an even larger delta pushing out into the sea against stronger tides, I will next describe the delta of the Ganges and Brahmaputra (or Burrampooter). These two major rivers of India originate from the highest mountains in the world and partially mix their waters in the low plains of Hindostan, before reaching the head of the Bay of Bengal. The Brahmaputra, which is somewhat larger, used to flow east of Dacca, as recently as the start of this century, directing most of its waters into one of the many channels in the delta known as "the Megna." By 276, that is how the main stream was consistently referred to by Rennell and others in their writings about this region. However, the main trunk now merges with a branch of the Ganges much farther upstream, about 100 miles from the sea, and it is continually, according to Dr. Hooker, shifting westward, having previously, as shown by ancient maps, flowed eastward for an extended period.

The area of the delta of the combined rivers, for it is impossible now to distinguish what belongs to each, is considerably more than double that of the Nile, even if we exclude from the delta a large extent of low, flat, alluvial plain, doubtless of fluviatile origin, which stretches more than 100 miles to the hills west of Calcutta (see map, fig. 25), and much farther in a northerly direction beyond the head of the great delta. The head of a delta is that point where the first arm is given off. Above that point a river receives the waters of tributaries flowing from higher levels; below it, on the contrary, it gives out portions of its waters to lower levels, through channels which flow into adjoining swamps, or which run directly to the sea. The Mississippi, as before described, has a single head, which originated at an unknown period when the Red River joined it. In the great delta of Bengal there may be said to be two heads nearly equidistant from the sea, that of the Ganges (G, map, fig. 25), about 30 miles below Rajmahal, or 216 statute miles in a direct line from the sea, and that of the Brahmapootra (B), below Chirapoonjee, where the river issues from the Khasia mountains, a distance of 224 miles from the Bay of Bengal.

The area of the delta formed by the combined rivers is significantly more than twice that of the Nile. This is true even if we exclude a large section of low, flat, alluvial plain, definitely formed by rivers, that stretches over 100 miles to the hills west of Calcutta (see map, fig. 25) and much farther north beyond the head of the great delta. The head of a delta is the point where the first branch splits off. Above that point, a river collects water from tributaries coming down from higher areas; below it, the river releases some of its water to lower areas through channels that flow into nearby swamps or directly into the sea. The Mississippi, as mentioned earlier, has a single head that formed at an unknown time when the Red River joined it. In the vast delta of Bengal, there are two heads that are almost equidistant from the sea: the Ganges (G, map, fig. 25), located about 30 miles below Rajmahal, or 216 statute miles directly from the sea, and the Brahmaputra (B), located below Chirapoonjee, where the river emerges from the Khasia mountains, a distance of 224 miles from the Bay of Bengal.

It will appear, by reference to the map, that the great body of fresh water derived from the two rivers enters the bay on its eastern side; and that a large part of the delta bordering on the sea is composed of a labyrinth of rivers and creeks, all filled with salt water, except those immediately communicating with the Hoogly, or principal arm of the Ganges. This tract alone, known by the name of the Woods, or Sunderbunds (more properly Soonderbuns), a wilderness infested by tigers and crocodiles, is, according to Rennell, equal in extent to the whole principality of Wales.369

It will be evident from the map that the large body of fresh water from the two rivers flows into the bay on its eastern side; and a significant part of the delta near the sea is made up of a maze of rivers and creeks, all filled with salt water, except for those directly connected to the Hoogly, or the main branch of the Ganges. This area alone, known as the Woods or Sunderbunds (more accurately Soonderbuns), is a wilderness filled with tigers and crocodiles and, according to Rennell, is as extensive as the entire principality of Wales.369

On the sea-coast there are eight great openings, each of which has evidently, at some ancient period, served in its turn as the principal channel of discharge. Although the flux and reflux of the tide extend even to the heads of the delta when the rivers are low, yet, when they are periodically swollen by tropical rains, their volume and velocity counteract the tidal current, so that, except very near the sea, the ebb and flow become insensible. During the flood season, therefore, the Ganges and Brahmapootra almost assume in their delta, the character of rivers entering an inland sea; the movements of the ocean being then subordinate to the force of the rivers, and only slightly disturbing their operations. The great gain of the delta in height and area takes place during the inundations; and, during other seasons of the year, the 277 ocean makes reprisals, scouring out the channels, and sometimes devouring rich alluvial plains.

On the coast, there are eight major openings, each of which clearly functioned as the main outlet at some point in the past. While the rise and fall of the tide reaches even to the edges of the delta when the rivers are low, when they swell periodically due to tropical rains, their flow and speed overwhelm the tidal current. As a result, except very close to the sea, the ebb and flow become barely noticeable. During the flood season, the Ganges and Brahmaputra almost take on the characteristics of rivers flowing into an inland sea in their delta; the movements of the ocean become less important compared to the power of the rivers, only slightly affecting their flow. The delta gains height and area mainly during the floods, and at other times of the year, the 277 ocean retaliates by eroding the channels and sometimes swallowing rich alluvial plains.

Islands formed and destroyed.—Major R. H. Colebrooke, in his account of the course of the Ganges, relates examples of the rapid filling up of some of its branches, and the excavation of new channels, where the number of square miles of soil removed in a short time (the column of earth being 114 feet high) was truly astonishing. Forty square miles, or 25,600 acres, are mentioned as having been carried away, in one place, in the course of a few years.370 The immense transportation of earthy matter by the Ganges and Brahmapootra is proved by the great magnitude of the islands formed in their channels during a period far short of that of a man's life. Some of these, many miles in extent, have originated in large sand-banks thrown up round the points at the angular turning of the rivers, and afterwards insulated by breaches of the streams. Others, formed in the main channel, are caused by some obstruction at the bottom. A large tree, or a sunken boat, is sometimes sufficient to check the current, and cause a deposit of sand, which accumulates till it usurps a considerable portion of the channel. The river then undermines its banks on each side, to supply the deficiency in its bed, and the island is afterwards raised by fresh deposits during every flood. In the great gulf below Luckipour, formed by the united waters of the Ganges and Megna, some of the islands, says Rennell, rival in size and fertility the Isle of Wight. While the river is forming new islands in one part, it is sweeping away old ones in others. Those newly formed are soon overrun with reeds, long grass, the Tamarix Indica, and other shrubs, forming impenetrable thickets, where the tiger, the rhinoceros, the buffalo, deer, and other wild animals, take shelter. It is easy, therefore, to perceive, that both animal and vegetable remains may occasionally be precipitated into the flood, and become imbedded in the sediment which subsides in the delta.

Islands are formed and destroyed.—Major R. H. Colebrooke, in his account of the Ganges, describes instances of how quickly some of its branches fill up and how new channels are created, noting the astonishing amount of soil removed in a short time (with the column of earth being 114 feet high). He mentions that in one place, 40 square miles or 25,600 acres were carried away over a few years.370 The massive amount of earth moved by the Ganges and Brahmaputra is evident in the large islands that formed in their channels over a time frame much shorter than a human lifespan. Some of these islands, spanning several miles, originated from large sandbanks that formed around the angular turns of the rivers and later became isolated due to breaches in the streams. Others, created in the main channel, are caused by obstructions on the riverbed. A large tree or a sunken boat can sometimes be enough to slow the current, leading to a deposit of sand that builds up until it takes up a significant part of the channel. The river then erodes its banks on both sides to make up for the loss in its bed, and the island gets raised by new deposits during each flood. In the large gulf below Luckipour, formed by the combined waters of the Ganges and Meghna, some of the islands, according to Rennell, rival the Isle of Wight in size and fertility. While the river creates new islands in one area, it erodes old ones in another. The newly formed islands quickly become overrun with reeds, tall grass, Tamarix Indica, and other shrubs, creating dense thickets where animals like tigers, rhinoceroses, buffalo, deer, and other wildlife find shelter. It is therefore easy to see how both animal and plant remains can occasionally be swept into the flood and become trapped in the sediment that settles in the delta.

Three or four species of crocodile, of two distinct sub-genera, abound in the Ganges, and its tributary and contiguous waters; and Mr. H. T. Colebrooke informed me, that he had seen both forms in places far inland, many hundred miles from the sea. The Gangetic crocodile, or Gavial (in correct orthography, Garial), is confined to the fresh water, living exclusively on fish, but the commoner kinds, called Koomiah and Muggar, frequent both fresh and salt, being much larger and fiercer in salt and brackish water.371 These animals swarm in the brackish water along the line of sand-banks, where the advance of the delta is most rapid. Hundreds of them are seen together in the creeks of the delta, 278 or basking in the sun on the shoals without. They will attack men and cattle, destroying the natives when bathing, and tame and wild animals which come to drink. "I have not unfrequently," says Mr. Colebrooke, "been witness to the horrid spectacle of a floating corpse seized by a crocodile with such avidity, that he half emerged above the water with his prey in his mouth." The geologist will not fail to observe how peculiarly the habits and distribution of these saurians expose them to become imbedded in the horizontal strata of fine mud, which are annually deposited over many hundred square miles in the Bay of Bengal. The inhabitants of the land, which happen to be drowned or thrown into the water, are usually devoured by these voracious reptiles; but we may suppose the remains of the saurians themselves to be continually entombed in the new formations. The number, also, of bodies of the poorer class of Hindoos thrown annually into the Ganges is so great, that some of their bones or skeletons can hardly fail to be occasionally enveloped in fluviatile mud.

Three or four species of crocodile, from two different sub-genera, are common in the Ganges and its nearby waters. Mr. H. T. Colebrooke told me he had seen both types far inland, many hundreds of miles from the sea. The Gangetic crocodile, or Gavial (correctly spelled Garial), is found only in freshwater and feeds exclusively on fish, but the more common types, known as Koomiah and Muggar, inhabit both fresh and saltwater, growing much larger and more aggressive in salt and brackish environments. These animals are abundant in the brackish waters along the sandbanks, where the delta is expanding rapidly. Hundreds can be seen together in the delta's creeks or sunbathing on the shoals. They will attack people and livestock, causing harm to locals while they bathe, as well as to any animals, tame or wild, that come to drink. "I have not infrequently," says Mr. Colebrooke, "witnessed the horrific sight of a floating corpse seized by a crocodile with such eagerness that it partially emerged from the water with its prey in its mouth." Geologists will notice how the habits and locations of these reptiles make them likely to be buried in the horizontal layers of fine mud that are deposited each year over vast areas in the Bay of Bengal. The land animals that drown or are thrown into the water are usually eaten by these hungry reptiles; however, we can assume that the remains of the crocodiles themselves are constantly being buried in new sediment. Additionally, the number of bodies from the poorer class of Hindoos thrown into the Ganges each year is so large that some bones or skeletons are likely to be periodically covered in river mud.

It sometimes happens, at the season when the periodical flood is at its height, that a strong gale of wind, conspiring with a high springtide, checks the descending current of the river, and gives rise to most destructive inundations. From this cause, in 1763, the waters at Luckipour rose six feet above their ordinary level, and the inhabitants of a considerable district, with their houses and cattle, were totally swept away.

It sometimes happens, during the time when the seasonal flood is at its peak, that a strong wind, combined with a high spring tide, slows down the river's current and causes very destructive floods. Because of this, in 1763, the waters at Luckipour rose six feet above their normal level, completely sweeping away the homes and livestock of many residents in a large area.

The population of all oceanic deltas are particularly exposed to suffer by such catastrophes, recurring at considerable intervals of time; and we may safely assume that such tragical events have happened again and again since the Gangetic delta was inhabited by man. If human experience and forethought cannot always guard against these calamities, still less can the inferior animals avoid them; and the monuments of such disastrous inundations must be looked for in great abundance in strata of all ages, if the surface of our planet has always been governed by the same laws. When we reflect on the general order and tranquillity that reigns in the rich and populous delta of Bengal, notwithstanding the havoc occasionally committed by the depredations of the ocean, we perceive how unnecessary it is to attribute the imbedding of successive races of animals in older strata to extraordinary energy in the causes of decay and reproduction in the infancy of our planet, or to those general catastrophes and sudden revolutions so often resorted to.

The populations of all oceanic deltas are particularly at risk of suffering from such disasters, which occur at significant intervals; we can safely assume that these tragic events have happened over and over since humans started living in the Gangetic delta. If human experience and planning can't always prevent these calamities, then even less so can the lower animals avoid them. The evidence of such disastrous floods must be found in abundance in geological layers of all ages, assuming that the surface of our planet has always followed the same natural laws. When we think about the general order and peace that exist in the rich and populous delta of Bengal, despite the destruction sometimes caused by the ocean, we realize how unnecessary it is to attribute the embedding of successive animal species in older layers to extraordinary forces of decay and reproduction in the early days of our planet, or to those widespread disasters and sudden changes that are frequently mentioned.

Deposits in the delta.—The quantity of mud held in suspension by the waters of the Ganges and Brahmapootra is found, as might be expected, to exceed that of any of the rivers alluded to in this or the preceding chapters; for, in the first place, their feeders flow from mountains of unrivalled altitude, and do not clear themselves in any lakes, as does the Rhine in the Lake of Constance, or the Rhone in that of Geneva. And, secondly, their whole course is nearer the equator than that of the Mississippi, or any great river, respecting which careful experiments have been made, to determine the quantity of its water and earthy contents. The fall of rain, moreover, as we have before seen, is 279 excessive on the southern flanks of the first range of mountains which rise from the plains of Hindostan, and still more remarkable is the quantity sometimes poured down in one day. (See above, p. 200.) The sea, where the Ganges and Brahmapootra discharge their main stream at the flood season, only recovers its transparency at the distance of from 60 to 100 miles from the delta; and we may take for granted that the current continues to transport the finer particles much farther south than where the surface water first becomes clear. The general slope, therefore, of the new strata must be extremely gentle. According to the best charts, there is a gradual deepening from four to about sixty fathoms, as we proceed from the base of the delta to the distance of about one hundred miles into the Bay of Bengal. At some few points seventy, or even one hundred, fathoms are obtained at that distance.

Deposits in the delta.—The amount of mud that the waters of the Ganges and Brahmaputra carry in suspension is, as expected, greater than that of any rivers mentioned in this or the previous chapters. This is because their tributaries flow from towering mountains, and they don’t pass through lakes that would filter them, like the Rhine does in Lake Constance or the Rhône in Lake Geneva. Furthermore, their entire route is closer to the equator than that of the Mississippi or any other major river that has been carefully studied to assess its water and sediment content. Additionally, as we’ve noted before, the rainfall is extremely heavy on the southern slopes of the first mountain range rising from the plains of Hindostan, with particularly remarkable amounts sometimes falling in a single day. (See above, p. 200.) The sea, where the Ganges and Brahmaputra empty their main flows during the flood season, doesn’t regain its clarity until about 60 to 100 miles away from the delta; it’s safe to assume that the current continues to carry the finer particles much further south than where the surface water first becomes clear. Thus, the overall slope of the new layers must be very gentle. According to the best charts, the depth gradually increases from four to about sixty fathoms as you move from the base of the delta to a distance of about one hundred miles into the Bay of Bengal. In a few locations, depths of seventy or even one hundred fathoms can be reached at that distance.

One remarkable exception, however, occurs to the regularity of the shape of the bottom. Opposite the middle of the delta, at the distance of thirty or forty miles from the coast, a deep submarine valley occurs, called the "swatch of no ground," about fifteen miles in diameter, where soundings of 180, and even 300, fathoms fail to reach the bottom. (See map, p. 275.) This phenomenon is the more extraordinary, since the depression runs north to within five miles of the line of shoals; and not only do the waters charged with sediment pass over it continually, but, during the monsoons, the sea, loaded with mud and sand, is beaten back in that direction towards the delta. As the mud is known to extend for eighty miles farther into the gulf, an enormous thickness of matter must have been deposited in "the swatch." We may conclude, therefore, either that the original depth of this part of the Bay of Bengal was excessive, or that subsidences have occurred in modern times. The latter conjecture is the less improbable, as the whole area of the delta has been convulsed in the historical era by earthquakes, and actual subsidences have taken place in the neighboring coast of Chittagong, while "the swatch" lies not far from the volcanic band which connects Sumatra, Barren Island, and Ramree.372

One remarkable exception, however, breaks the regularity of the shape of the bottom. Directly opposite the center of the delta, about thirty to forty miles from the coast, there’s a deep underwater valley known as the "swatch of no ground," which is about fifteen miles wide, where soundings of 180, and even 300, fathoms cannot reach the bottom. (See map, p. 275.) This phenomenon is even more unusual because the depression extends northward to within five miles of the shoals; and not only do the sediment-filled waters flow over it continuously, but during the monsoons, the sea, full of mud and sand, is pushed back in that direction toward the delta. Since the mud is known to extend eighty miles further into the gulf, a massive amount of material must have accumulated in "the swatch." Therefore, we can conclude that either the original depth of this part of the Bay of Bengal was very deep, or that there have been sinkholes recently. The latter theory is not unlikely, as the entire delta area has experienced earthquakes during historical times, and there have been actual sinkholes along the nearby Chittagong coast, while "the swatch" is not far from the volcanic belt connecting Sumatra, Barren Island, and Ramree.372

Opposite the mouth of the Hoogly river, and immediately south of Saugor Island, four miles from the nearest land of the delta, a new islet was formed about twenty years ago, called Edmonstone Island, on the centre of which a beacon was erected as a landmark in 1817. In 1818 the island had become two miles long and half a mile broad, and was covered with vegetation and shrubs. Some houses were then built upon it, and in 1820 it was used as a pilot station. The severe gale of 1823 divided it into two parts, and so reduced its size as to leave the beacon standing out in the sea, where, after remaining seven years, it was washed away. The islet in 1836 had been converted by successive storms into a sand-bank, half a mile long, on which a sea-mark was placed.

Opposite the mouth of the Hoogly River, just south of Saugor Island and four miles from the nearest land of the delta, a new islet was formed about twenty years ago, called Edmonstone Island. A beacon was set up in the center as a landmark in 1817. By 1818, the island had grown to two miles long and half a mile wide, covered in vegetation and shrubs. Some houses were built on it, and in 1820 it became a pilot station. A severe storm in 1823 split the island into two parts and reduced its size, leaving the beacon standing out in the sea, where it remained for seven years before being washed away. By 1836, the islet had been turned into a sandbank, half a mile long, on which a sea-mark was placed.

Although there is evidence of gain at some points, the general progress of the coast is very slow; for the tides, when the river water is low, are actively employed in removing alluvial matter. In the Sunderbunds 280 the usual rise and fall of the tides is no more than eight feet, but, on the east side of the delta, Dr. Hooker observed, in the winter of 1851, a rise of from sixty to eighty feet, producing among the islands at the mouths of the Megna and Fenny rivers, a lofty wave or "bore" as they ascend, and causing the river water to be ponded back, and then to sweep down with great violence when the tide ebbs. The bay for forty miles south of Chittagong is so fresh that neither algæ nor mangroves will grow in it. We may, therefore, conceive how effective may be the current formed by so great a volume of water in dispersing fine mud over a wide area. Its power is sometimes augmented by the agitation of the bay during hurricanes in the month of May. The new superficial strata consists entirely of fine sand and mud; such, at least, are the only materials which are exposed to view in regular beds on the banks of the numerous creeks. Neither here or higher up the Ganges, could Dr. Hooker discover any land or freshwater shells in sections of the banks, which in the plains higher up sometimes form cliffs eighty feet in height at low water. In like manner I have stated373 that I was unable to find any buried shells in the delta or modern river cliffs of the Mississippi.

Although there is evidence of some gains at certain locations, the overall progress of the coast is very slow; the tides, when the river water is low, actively work to remove alluvial material. In the Sunderbunds, the typical rise and fall of the tides is no more than eight feet, but on the eastern side of the delta, Dr. Hooker noted in the winter of 1851 a rise of sixty to eighty feet, creating a significant wave or "bore" among the islands at the mouths of the Meghna and Feni rivers as they rise, which causes the river water to back up and then rush down violently when the tide goes out. The bay for forty miles south of Chittagong is so fresh that neither algae nor mangroves can grow there. Therefore, we can imagine how effective the current from such a large volume of water is at spreading fine mud over a wide area. Its force is sometimes increased by the agitation of the bay during hurricanes in May. The new top layers consist entirely of fine sand and mud; at least, these are the only materials visible in regular beds along the banks of the numerous creeks. Neither here nor higher up the Ganges did Dr. Hooker find any land or freshwater shells in the sections of the banks, which in the higher plains sometimes form cliffs that are eighty feet high at low water. Similarly, I have stated that I was unable to find any buried shells in the delta or modern river cliffs of the Mississippi.

No substance so coarse as gravel occurs in any part of the delta of the Ganges and Brahmapootra, nor nearer the sea than 400 miles. Yet it is remarkable that the boring of an Artesian well at Fort William, near Calcutta, in the years 1835-1840, displayed, at the depth of 120 feet, clay and sand with pebbles. This boring was carried to a depth of 481 feet below the level of Calcutta, and the geological section obtained in the operation has been recorded with great care. Under the surface soil, at a depth of about ten feet, they came to a stiff blue clay about forty feet in thickness; below which was sandy clay, containing in its lower portion abundance of decayed vegetable matter, which at the bottom assumed the character of a stratum of black peat two feet thick. This peaty mass was considered as a clear indication (like the "dirt-bed" of Portland) of an ancient terrestrial surface, with a forest or Sunderbund vegetation. Logs and branches of a red-colored wood occur both above and immediately below the peat, so little altered that Dr. Wallich was able to identify them with the Soondri tree, Heritiera littoralis, one of the most prevalent forms, at the base of the delta. Dr. Falconer tells me that similar peat has been met with at other points round Calcutta at the depth of nine feet and twenty-five feet. It appears, therefore, that there has been a sinking down of what was originally land in this region, to the amount of seventy feet or more perpendicular; for Calcutta is only a few feet above the level of the sea, and the successive peat-beds seem to imply that the subsidence of the ground was gradual or interrupted by several pauses. Below the vegetable mass they entered upon a stratum of yellowish clay about ten feet thick, containing horizontal layers of kunkar (or kankar), a nodular, concretionary, argillaceous limestone, met with abundantly at greater or 281 less depths in all parts of the valley of the Ganges, over many thousand square miles, and always presenting the same characters, even at a distance of one thousand miles north of Calcutta. Some of this kunkar is said to be of very recent origin in deposits formed by river inundations near Saharanpoor. After penetrating 120 feet, they found loam containing water-worn fragments of mica-slate and other kinds of rock, which the current of the Ganges can no longer transport to this region. In the various beds pierced through below, consisting of clay, marl, and friable sandstone, with kunkar here and there intermixed, no organic remains of decidedly marine origin were met with. Too positive a conclusion ought not, it is true, to be drawn from such a fact, when we consider the narrow bore of the auger and its effect in crushing shells and bones. Nevertheless, it is worthy of remark, that the only fossils obtained in a recognizable state were of a fluviatile or terrestrial character. Thus, at the depth of 350 feet, the bony shell of a tortoise, or trionyx, a freshwater genus, was found in sand, resembling the living species of Bengal. From the same stratum, also, they drew up the lower half of the humerus of a ruminant, at first referred to a hyæna. It was the size and shape, says Dr. Falconer, of the shoulder-bone of the Cervus porcinus, or common hog-deer, of India. At the depth of 380 feet, clay with fragments of lacustrine shells was incumbent on what appears clearly to have been another "dirt-bed," or stratum of decayed wood, implying a period of repose of some duration, and a forest-covered land, which must have subsided 300 feet, to admit of the subsequent superposition of the overlying deposits. It has been conjectured that, at the time when this area supported trees, the land extended much farther out into the Bay of Bengal than now, and that in later times the Ganges, while enlarging its delta, has been only recovering lost ground from the sea.

No material as coarse as gravel is found anywhere in the delta of the Ganges and Brahmaputra, nor within 400 miles of the sea. However, it’s interesting that when an Artesian well was drilled at Fort William, near Calcutta, between 1835 and 1840, they uncovered clay and sand mixed with pebbles at a depth of 120 feet. The well was drilled down to 481 feet below the level of Calcutta, and the geological layers encountered were carefully documented. Below the surface soil, around ten feet deep, they discovered a thick layer of stiff blue clay about forty feet thick. Beneath that was sandy clay, which in its lower part contained a lot of decayed plant material that turned into a two-foot thick layer of black peat at the bottom. This peaty layer was seen as clear evidence (similar to the "dirt-bed" of Portland) of an ancient land surface that had a forest or Sunderbund vegetation. Logs and branches of a reddish wood were found both above and below the peat, preserved enough for Dr. Wallich to identify them as belonging to the Soondri tree, Heritiera littoralis, one of the most common species at the base of the delta. Dr. Falconer mentioned that similar peat has also been found at other locations around Calcutta at depths of nine feet and twenty-five feet. It appears, therefore, that the land in this area has sunk by seventy feet or more; since Calcutta is only a few feet above sea level, and the layers of peat suggest that the ground subsided gradually with several pauses. Below the layer of plant material, they found a stratum of yellowish clay about ten feet thick, which contained horizontal layers of kunkar (or kankar), a nodular, compact limestone commonly found at various depths across thousands of square miles in the Ganges valley, exhibiting consistent characteristics even a thousand miles north of Calcutta. Some of this kunkar is thought to have formed recently from river floods near Saharanpur. After reaching 120 feet, they found loam containing water-worn bits of mica-slate and other types of rock, which the Ganges current can no longer carry to this area. In the different layers that were drilled through below, made up of clay, marl, and loose sandstone, with kunkar mixed in occasionally, no organic remains of clearly marine origin were found. It’s true that no definite conclusions should be drawn from this fact since the narrow bore of the auger can crush shells and bones. However, it’s worth noting that the only recognizable fossils discovered were of freshwater or land origin. For instance, at a depth of 350 feet, they found the bony shell of a freshwater tortoise, or trionyx, in sand, resembling living species in Bengal. From the same layer, they also recovered the lower half of the humerus of a ruminant, initially thought to belong to a hyena. Dr. Falconer described it as the size and shape of the shoulder bone of the Cervus porcinus, or common hog-deer, of India. At 380 feet deep, clay with pieces of freshwater shells was resting on what seems to have been another "dirt-bed," or layer of decayed wood, indicating a period of relative stability and a land covered by forest, which must have sunk 300 feet to allow the layers above to form. It’s been suggested that when this area was forested, the land extended much further into the Bay of Bengal than it does now, and in more recent times, the Ganges has been gradually reclaiming land from the sea as it expands its delta.

At the depth of about 400 feet below the surface, an abrupt change was observed in the character of the strata, which were composed in great part of sand, shingle, and boulders, the only fossils observed being the vertebræ of a crocodile, shell of a trionyx, and fragments of wood very little altered, and similar to that buried in beds far above. These gravelly beds constituted the bottom of the section at the depth of 481 feet, when the operations were discontinued, in consequence of an accident which happened to the auger.

At a depth of around 400 feet below the surface, a sudden change was noted in the type of layers, which were mostly made up of sand, gravel, and large stones. The only fossils found were the vertebrae of a crocodile, the shell of a trionyx, and some partially preserved wood that was similar to what was buried in higher layers. These gravelly layers were at the bottom of the section when the depth reached 481 feet, at which point work stopped due to an accident with the auger.

The occurrence of pebbles at the depths of 120 and 400 feet implies an important change in the geographical condition of the region around or near Calcutta. The fall of the river, or the general slope of the alluvial plain may have been formerly greater; or, before a general and perhaps unequal subsidence, hills once nearer the present base of the delta may have risen several hundred feet, forming islands in the bay, which may have sunk gradually, and become buried under fluviatile sediment.

The presence of pebbles at depths of 120 and 400 feet suggests a significant change in the geographical conditions around Calcutta. The river's descent, or the overall slope of the alluvial plain, might have been steeper in the past; or, prior to a general and possibly uneven sinking of the land, hills that were once closer to the current base of the delta could have risen several hundred feet, creating islands in the bay that may have gradually submerged and become covered by river sediment.

Antiquity of the delta.—It would be a matter of no small scientific interest, if experiments were made to enable us to determine, with some degree of accuracy, the mean quantity of earthy matter discharged annually282 into the sea by the united waters of the Ganges and Brahmapootra. The Rev. Mr. Everest instituted, in 1831-2, a series of observations on the earthy matter brought down by the Ganges, at Ghazepoor, 500 miles from the sea. He found that, in 1831, the number of cubic feet of water discharged by the river per second at that place was, during the

Antiquity of the delta.—It would be of great scientific interest if we could conduct experiments to figure out, with some accuracy, the average amount of sediment discharged each year into the sea by the combined waters of the Ganges and Brahmaputra. The Rev. Mr. Everest began a series of observations on the sediment carried by the Ganges at Ghazepoor, 500 miles from the sea, in 1831-2. He found that, in 1831, the amount of water flowing from the river per second at that location was, during the

Rains (4 months) 494,208
Winter (5 months) 71,200
Hot weather (3 months) 36,330

so that we may state in round numbers that 500,000 cubic feet per second flow down during the four months of the flood season, from June to September, and less than 60,000 per second during the remaining eight months.

so that we can say in approximate numbers that 500,000 cubic feet per second flows down during the four months of the flood season, from June to September, and less than 60,000 per second during the other eight months.

The average quantity of solid matter suspended in the water during the rains was, by weight, 1/428th part; but as the water is about one-half the specific gravity of the dried mud, the solid matter discharged is 1/856th part in bulk, or 577 cubic feet per second. This gives a total of 6,082,041,600 cubic feet for the discharge in the 122 days of the rain. The proportion of sediment in the waters at other seasons was comparatively insignificant, the total amount during the five winter months being only 247,881,600 cubic feet, and during the three months of hot weather 38,154,240 cubic feet. The total annual discharge, then, would be 6,368,077,440 cubic feet.

The average amount of solid material suspended in the water during the rains was 1/428th by weight; however, since the water has about half the specific gravity of the dried mud, the solid matter released is 1/856th in volume, which equals 577 cubic feet per second. This results in a total of 6,082,041,600 cubic feet discharged over the 122 days of rain. The amount of sediment in the water during other seasons was relatively minor, with the total for the five winter months being just 247,881,600 cubic feet, and during the three months of hot weather, it was 38,154,240 cubic feet. So, the total annual discharge would be 6,368,077,440 cubic feet.

This quantity of mud would in one year raise a surface of 228½ square miles, or a square space, each side of which should measure 15 miles, a height of one foot. To give some idea of the magnitude of this result, we will assume that the specific gravity of the dried mud is only one-half that of granite (it would, however, be more); in that case, the earthy matter discharged in a year would equal 3,184,038,720 cubic feet of granite. Now about 12½ cubic feet of granite weigh one ton; and it is computed that the great Pyramid of Egypt, if it were a solid mass of granite, would weigh about 600,000,000 tons. The mass of matter, therefore, carried down annually would, according to this estimate, more than equal in weight and bulk forty-two of the great pyramids of Egypt, and that borne down in the four months of the rains would equal forty pyramids. But if, without any conjecture as to what may have been the specific gravity of the mud, we attend merely to the weight of solid matter actually proved by Mr. Everest to have been contained in the water, we find that the number of tons weight which passed down in the 122 days of the rainy season was 339,413,760, which would give the weight of fifty-six pyramids and a half; and in the whole year 355,361,464 tons, or nearly the weight of sixty pyramids.

This amount of mud would, in one year, cover an area of 228½ square miles, or a square space with each side measuring 15 miles, to a height of one foot. To illustrate the scale of this result, let’s assume the specific gravity of the dried mud is only half that of granite (though it’s likely more); in this case, the earthy material discharged in a year would be equivalent to 3,184,038,720 cubic feet of granite. Since about 12½ cubic feet of granite weigh one ton, it’s estimated that if the Great Pyramid of Egypt were a solid block of granite, it would weigh around 600,000,000 tons. Thus, the mass of material carried down annually would, by this estimate, weigh and bulk more than forty-two of the Great Pyramids of Egypt, and the amount moved during the four months of rain would equal forty pyramids. However, without speculating on the specific gravity of the mud, if we only look at the solid matter actually measured by Mr. Everest in the water, we find that 339,413,760 tons of weight were carried down in the 122 days of the rainy season, which would be equivalent to fifty-six and a half pyramids; and in the entire year, it totals 355,361,464 tons, or nearly the weight of sixty pyramids.

The base of the great Pyramid of Egypt covers eleven acres, and its perpendicular height is about five hundred feet. It is scarcely possible to present any picture to the mind which will convey an adequate conception of the mighty scale of this operation, so tranquilly and almost insensibly carried on by the Ganges, as it glides through its alluvial 283 plain, even at a distance of 500 miles from the sea. It may, however, be stated, that if a fleet of more than eighty Indiamen, each freighted with about 1400 tons' weight of mud, were to sail down the river every hour of every day and night for four months continuously, they would only transport from the higher country to the sea a mass of solid matter equal to that borne down by the Ganges, even in this part of its course, in the four months of the flood season. Or the exertions of a fleet of about 2000 such ships going down daily with the same burden, and discharging it into the gulf, would be no more than equivalent to the operations of the great river.

The base of the great Pyramid of Egypt spans eleven acres, and its height reaches about five hundred feet. It’s nearly impossible to imagine an image that truly captures the immense scale of this process, so quietly and almost imperceptibly carried out by the Ganges as it flows through its alluvial plain, even when viewed from 500 miles away from the sea. However, it can be said that if a fleet of over eighty large ships, each carrying about 1400 tons of mud, were to travel down the river every hour of every day and night for four straight months, they would only move a volume of solid material equal to what the Ganges carries in this section during the four months of the flood season. Alternatively, the efforts of a fleet of about 2000 such ships sailing daily with the same load and releasing it into the gulf would be no more than what the great river accomplishes.

The most voluminous current of lava which has flowed from Etna within historical times was that of 1669. Ferrara, after correcting Borelli's estimate, calculated the quantity of cubic yards of lava in this current at 140,000,000. Now, this would not equal in bulk one-fifth of the sedimentary matter which is carried down in a single year by the Ganges, past Ghazepoor, according to the estimate above explained; so that it would require five grand eruptions of Etna to transfer a mass of lava from the subterranean regions to the surface, equal in volume to the mud carried down in one year to that place.

The largest flow of lava from Etna recorded in history occurred in 1669. Ferrara, after revising Borelli's estimate, calculated the volume of this lava flow to be 140,000,000 cubic yards. However, this amount is less than one-fifth of the sediment carried down by the Ganges in just one year near Ghazepoor, based on previous estimates. This means it would take five major eruptions of Etna to bring up a volume of lava from below the surface that matches the amount of mud the Ganges transports to that area in a single year.

Captain R. Strachey, of the Bengal Engineers, has remarked to me, not only that Ghazepoor, where Mr. Everest's observations were made, is 500 miles from the sea, but that the Ganges has not been joined there by its most important feeders. These drain upon the whole 750 miles of the Himalaya, and no more than 150 miles of that mountain-chain have sent their contributions to the main trunk at Ghazepoor. Below that place, the Ganges is joined by the Gogra, Gunduk, Khosee, and Teesta from the north, to say nothing of the Sone flowing from the south, one of the largest of the rivers which rise in the table-land of central India. (See map, fig. 25, p. 275.) Moreover the remaining 600 miles of the Himalaya comprise that eastern portion of the basin where the rains are heaviest. (See above, p. 200.) The quantity of water therefore carried down to the sea may probably be four or five times as much as that which passes Ghazepoor.

Captain R. Strachey, of the Bengal Engineers, mentioned to me not only that Ghazepoor, where Mr. Everest made his observations, is 500 miles from the sea, but also that the Ganges has not been joined there by its most significant tributaries. These tributaries drain across the entire 750 miles of the Himalayas, and only 150 miles of that mountain range have contributed to the main river at Ghazepoor. Below that point, the Ganges is joined by the Gogra, Gunduk, Khosee, and Teesta from the north, in addition to the Sone flowing from the south, which is one of the largest rivers originating in the central Indian plateau. (See map, fig. 25, p. 275.) Moreover, the remaining 600 miles of the Himalayas consist of the eastern part of the basin where the rains are the heaviest. (See above, p. 200.) Therefore, the amount of water carried down to the sea may be four or five times greater than what passes by Ghazepoor.

The Brahmapootra, according to Major Wilcox,374 in the month of January, when it is near its minimum, discharges 150,000 cubic feet of water per second at Gwalpara, not many miles above the head of its delta. Taking the proportions observed at Ghazepoor at the different seasons as a guide, the probable average discharge of the Brahmapootra for the whole year may be estimated at about the same as that of the Ganges. Assuming this; and secondly, in order to avoid the risk of exaggeration, that the proportion of sediment in their waters is about a third less than Mr. Everest's estimate, the mud borne down to the Bay of Bengal in one year would equal 40,000 millions of cubic feet, or between six and seven times as much as that brought down to Ghazepoor, according to Mr. Everest's calculations in 1831, and ten times as much as that conveyed annually by the Mississippi to the Gulf of Mexico.

The Brahmaputra, according to Major Wilcox,374 in January, when the river is close to its lowest point, releases 150,000 cubic feet of water per second at Gwalpara, just a few miles upstream from the start of its delta. Using the measurements taken at Ghazepoor during different seasons as a reference, the average discharge of the Brahmaputra for the entire year can be estimated to be roughly the same as that of the Ganges. If we assume this and also consider that the amount of sediment in their waters is about a third less than Mr. Everest's estimation to avoid overstating the figures, the amount of mud carried down to the Bay of Bengal in one year would be 40,000 million cubic feet, which is between six and seven times the amount reported by Mr. Everest in 1831 for Ghazepoor and ten times the amount that the Mississippi transports to the Gulf of Mexico annually.

284 Captain Strachey estimates the annually inundated portion of the delta at 250 miles in length by 80 in breadth, making an area of 20,000 square miles. The space south of this in the bay, where sediment is thrown down, may be 300 miles from E. to W. by 150 N. and S., or 45,000 square miles, which, added to the former, gives a surface of 65,000 square miles, over which the sediment is spread out by the two rivers. Suppose then the solid matter to amount to 40,000 millions of cubic feet per annum, the deposit, he observes, must be continued for forty-five years and three-tenths to raise the whole area a height of one foot, or 13,600 years to raise it 300 feet; and this, as we have seen, is much less than the thickness of the fluviatile strata actually penetrated, (and the bottom not reached) by the auger at Calcutta.

284 Captain Strachey estimates the flooded area of the delta to be 250 miles long and 80 miles wide, covering 20,000 square miles. The region to the south in the bay, where sediment accumulates, may stretch 300 miles from east to west and 150 miles north to south, or 45,000 square miles. When combined with the previous area, this results in a total surface of 65,000 square miles over which sediment is spread by the two rivers. If we consider the solid matter to be 40 billion cubic feet per year, he notes that it would take 45.3 years to raise the entire area by one foot, or 13,600 years to raise it by 300 feet; and this, as we have seen, is significantly less than the thickness of the riverine layers that have been actually drilled through (with the bottom not reached) in Calcutta.

Nevertheless we can by no means deduce from these data alone, what will be the future rate of advance of the delta, nor even predict whether the land will gain on the sea, or remain stationary. At the end of 13,000 years the bay may be less shallow than now, provided a moderate depression, corresponding to that experienced in part of Greenland for many centuries shall take place (see chap. 30). A subsidence quite insensible to the inhabitants of Bengal, not exceeding two feet three inches in a century, would be more than sufficient to counterbalance all the efforts of the two mighty rivers to extend the limits of their delta. We have seen that the Artesian borings at Calcutta attest, what the vast depth of the "swatch" may also in all likelihood indicate, that the antagonist force of subsidence has predominated for ages over the influx of fluviatile mud, preventing it from raising the plains of Bengal, or from filling up a larger portion of the bay.

Nevertheless, we can't determine from this data alone what the future rate of advance of the delta will be, nor can we predict whether the land will expand into the sea or stay the same. After 13,000 years, the bay might be less shallow than it is now, assuming a moderate depression, similar to what part of Greenland experienced for many centuries, occurs (see chap. 30). A subsidence that is barely noticeable to the people of Bengal, not exceeding two feet three inches in a century, would be more than enough to offset all the efforts of the two powerful rivers to extend their delta. We've seen that the Artesian borings at Calcutta confirm, and the vast depth of the "swatch" likely indicates, that the opposing force of subsidence has, for ages, outweighed the influx of river mud, preventing it from raising the plains of Bengal or filling up a larger part of the bay.

CONCLUDING REMARKS ON DELTAS.

Convergence of deltas.—If we possessed an accurate series of maps of the Adriatic for many thousand years, our retrospect would, without doubt, carry us gradually back to the time when the number of rivers descending from the mountains into that gulf by independent deltas was far greater in number. The deltas of the Po and the Adige, for instance, would separate themselves within the recent era, as, in all probability, would those of the Isonzo and the Torre. If, on the other hand, we speculate on future changes, we may anticipate the period when the number of deltas will greatly diminish; for the Po cannot continue to encroach at the rate of a mile in a hundred years, and other rivers to gain as much in six or seven centuries upon the shallow gulf, without new junctions occurring from time to time; so that Eridanus, "the king of rivers," will continually boast a greater number of tributaries. The Ganges and the Brahmapootra have perhaps become partially confluent in the same delta within the historical, or at least within the human era; and the date of the junction of the Red River and the Mississippi would, in all likelihood, have been known, if America had not been so recently discovered. The union of the Tigris and the Euphrates must undoubtedly have been one of the modern geographical changes of our Earth, 285 for Col. Rawlinson informs me that the delta of those rivers has advanced two miles in the last sixty years, and is supposed to have encroached about forty miles upon the Gulf of Persia in the course of the last twenty-five centuries.

Convergence of deltas.—If we had a detailed series of maps of the Adriatic going back thousands of years, our view would clearly show us a time when many more rivers flowed down from the mountains into that gulf, each with its own delta. The deltas of the Po and the Adige, for example, would have separated more recently, and likely so would those of the Isonzo and the Torre. On the flip side, if we think about future changes, we can foresee a time when the number of deltas will significantly decline; the Po can't keep expanding at the rate of a mile every hundred years, and other rivers can't keep gaining as much in six or seven centuries in the shallow gulf, without new connections forming from time to time. This means that Eridanus, "the king of rivers," will always have more tributaries. The Ganges and the Brahmaputra may have already merged partially in the same delta within recorded history, or at least within the human era; and we would probably know when the Red River joined the Mississippi if America hadn't been discovered so recently. The merging of the Tigris and the Euphrates must surely rank among the modern geographical changes of our Earth, 285 as Col. Rawlinson tells me that the delta of those rivers has moved two miles forward in the last sixty years and is believed to have encroached about forty miles into the Gulf of Persia over the past twenty-five centuries.

When the deltas of rivers, having many mouths, converge, a partial union at first takes place by the confluence of some one or more of their arms; but it is not until the main trunks are connected above the head of the common delta, that a complete intermixture of their joint waters and sediment takes place. The union, therefore, of the Po and Adige, and of the Ganges and Brahmapootra, is still incomplete. If we reflect on the geographical extent of surface drained by rivers such as now enter the Bay of Bengal, and then consider how complete the blending together of the greater part of their transported matter has already become, and throughout how vast a delta it is spread by numerous arms, we no longer feel so much surprise at the area occupied by some ancient formations of homogeneous mineral composition. But our surprise will be still farther lessened, when we afterwards inquire (ch. 21) into the action of tides and currents in disseminating sediment.

When the deltas of rivers, which have many mouths, come together, a partial union initially happens through the merging of one or more of their branches; but it's not until the main streams connect above the starting point of the common delta that a complete mixing of their waters and sediment occurs. Therefore, the union of the Po and Adige, as well as the Ganges and Brahmaputra, is still not complete. If we think about the geographical area drained by rivers that currently flow into the Bay of Bengal, and then consider how fully the majority of their transported materials have already mixed together across such a vast delta with numerous branches, we no longer find it as surprising that some ancient formations of consistent mineral composition occupy such an area. However, our surprise will be even further reduced when we later examine (ch. 21) how tides and currents help spread sediment.

Age of existing deltas.—If we could take for granted, that the relative level of land and sea had remained stationary ever since all the existing deltas began to be formed—could we assume that their growth commenced at one and the same instant when the present continents acquired their actual shape—we might understand the language of geologists who speak of "the epoch of existing continents." They endeavor to calculate the age of deltas from this imaginary fixed period; and they calculate the gain of new land upon the sea, at the mouths of rivers, as having begun everywhere simultaneously. But the more we study the history of deltas, the more we become convinced that upward and downward movements of the land and contiguous bed of the sea have exerted, and continue to exert, an influence on the physical geography of many hydrographical basins, on a scale comparable in magnitude or importance to the amount of fluviatile deposition effected in an equal lapse of time. In the basin of the Mississippi, for example, proofs both of descending and ascending movements to a vertical amount of several hundred feet can be shown to have taken place since the existing species of land and freshwater shells lived in that region.375

Age of existing deltas.—If we could assume that the relative level of land and sea has remained unchanged since all the current deltas started to form—could we think that their growth began at the same moment when the present continents took their current shape—we might understand what geologists mean when they talk about "the epoch of existing continents." They try to estimate the age of deltas from this hypothetical fixed point; and they calculate the addition of new land to the sea, at the mouths of rivers, as having started everywhere at the same time. However, the more we investigate the history of deltas, the more we realize that the rising and falling movements of the land and nearby sea floor have had, and still have, a significant impact on the physical geography of many watersheds, comparable in scale or significance to the amount of sedimentation that happens over the same period. In the Mississippi basin, for instance, evidence of both subsiding and rising movements, amounting to several hundred feet vertically, can be demonstrated to have occurred since the current species of land and freshwater shells lived in that area.375

The deltas also of the Po and Ganges have each, as we have seen (p. 257), when probed by the Artesian auger, borne testimony to a gradual subsidence of land to the extent of several hundred feet—old terrestrial surfaces, turf, peat, forest-land, and "dirt-beds," having been pierced at various depths. The changes of level at the mouth of the Indus in Cutch (see below, chap. 27), and those of New Madrid in the valley of the Mississippi (see p. 270, and chap. 27), are equally instructive, as demonstrating unceasing fluctuations in the levels of those areas into which running water is transporting sediment. If, therefore, the exact 286 age of all modern deltas could be known, it is scarcely probable that we should find any two of them in the world to have coincided in date, or in the time when their earliest deposits originated.

The deltas of the Po and Ganges have each shown, as we noted (p. 257), when examined with the Artesian auger, evidence of a gradual sinking of land by several hundred feet—old land surfaces, grass, peat, forest ground, and "dirt-beds" have been penetrated at various depths. The changes in elevation at the mouth of the Indus in Cutch (see below, chap. 27), and those in New Madrid in the Mississippi valley (see p. 270, and chap. 27), are also very informative, showing constant fluctuations in the levels of areas where rivers are depositing sediment. Therefore, if we could determine the exact age of all modern deltas, it is unlikely that we would find any two of them in the world having the same age, or originating their oldest deposits at the same time.

Grouping of strata in deltas.—The changes which have taken place in deltas, even within the times of history, may suggest many important considerations in regard to the manner in which subaqueous sediment is distributed. With the exception of some cases hereafter to be noticed, there are some general laws of arrangement which must evidently hold good in almost all the lakes and seas now filling up. If a lake, for example, be encircled on two sides by lofty mountains, receiving from them many rivers and torrents of different sizes, and if it be bounded on the other sides, where the surplus waters issue, by a comparatively low country, it is not difficult to define some of the leading geological features which must characterize the lacustrine formation, when this basin shall have been gradually converted into dry land by the influx of sediment. The strata would be divisible into two principal groups: the older comprising those deposits which originated on the side adjoining the mountains, where numerous deltas first began to form; and the newer group consisting of beds deposited in the more central parts of the basin, and towards the side farthest from the mountains. The following characters would form the principal marks of distinction between the strata in each series:—The more ancient system would be composed, for the most part, of coarser materials, containing many beds of pebbles and sand, often of great thickness, and sometimes dipping at a considerable angle. These, with associated beds of finer ingredients, would, if traced round the borders of the basin, be seen to vary greatly in color and mineral composition, and would also be very irregular in thickness. The beds, on the contrary, in the newer group, would consist of finer particles, and would be horizontal, or very slightly inclined. Their color and mineral composition would be very homogeneous throughout large areas, and would differ from almost all the separate beds in the older series.

Grouping of strata in deltas.—The changes that have occurred in deltas, even during historical times, can suggest many important ideas about how underwater sediment is distributed. With a few exceptions that will be mentioned later, there are some general rules of arrangement that likely apply to almost all the lakes and seas that are currently filling up. For instance, if a lake is surrounded on two sides by tall mountains, receiving many rivers and streams of different sizes from them, and if it is bounded on the other sides, where excess water flows out, by relatively flat land, it is not difficult to identify some key geological features that will define the lake's formation once this basin gradually turns into dry land due to sediment buildup. The layers of sediment would be divided into two main groups: the older group includes deposits that formed on the side next to the mountains, where many deltas first started to develop; while the newer group consists of layers deposited in the more central areas of the basin, and towards the side farthest from the mountains. The following characteristics would highlight the main differences between the layers in each group: the older system would primarily consist of coarser materials, featuring many thick layers of pebbles and sand, sometimes sloping at a significant angle. If you trace these layers around the edges of the basin, you'd see they vary greatly in color and mineral composition, and they would also be very uneven in thickness. In contrast, the layers in the newer group would consist of finer particles and would be mostly horizontal or slightly sloped. Their color and mineral composition would be quite uniform across large areas, and they would differ from nearly all the individual layers in the older group.

The following causes would produce the diversity here alluded to between the two great members of such lacustrine formations:—When the rivers and torrents first reach the edge of the lake, the detritus washed down by them from the adjoining heights sinks at once into deep water, all the heavier pebbles and sand subsiding near the shore. The finer mud is carried somewhat farther out, but not to the distance of many miles, for the greater part may be seen, as, for example, where the Rhone enters the Lake of Geneva, to fall down in clouds to the bottom, not far from the river's mouth. Thus alluvial tracts are soon formed at the mouths of every torrent and river, and many of these in the course of ages become of considerable extent. Pebbles and sand are then transported farther from the mountains; but in their passage they decrease in size by attrition, and are in part converted into mud and sand. At length some of the numerous deltas, which are all directed towards a common centre, approach near to each other; those 287 of adjoining torrents become united, and each is merged, in its turn, in the delta of the largest river, which advances most rapidly into the lake, and renders all the minor streams, one after the other, its tributaries. The various mineral ingredients of all are thus blended together into one homogeneous mixture, and the sediment is poured out from a common channel into the lake.

The following factors contribute to the diversity mentioned between the two major components of such lake formations: When rivers and streams first reach the edge of the lake, the debris they carry down from the nearby heights immediately sinks into deep water, with the heavier pebbles and sand settling near the shore. The finer mud goes a bit farther out, but not many miles away, as most can be seen, like at the Rhone’s entrance to Lake Geneva, falling down in clouds close to where the river meets the lake. This way, alluvial areas quickly form at the mouths of every torrent and river, and many of these grow considerably over time. Pebbles and sand are then carried away from the mountains; however, as they travel, they become smaller due to wear and partially turn into mud and sand. Eventually, several deltas that all point toward a common center come close to each other; deltas from adjacent streams merge, and each one gradually blends into the delta of the largest river, which extends most quickly into the lake, making all the smaller streams tributaries one after another. The different mineral components of all these are mixed together into a single uniform mixture, and the sediment is released from a common channel into the lake.

As the average size of the transported particles decreases, while the force and volume of the main river augments, the newer deposits are diffused continually over a wider area, and are consequently more horizontal than the older. When at first there were many independent deltas near the borders of the basin, their separate deposits differed entirely from each other; one may have been charged, like the Arve where it joins the Rhone, with white sand and sediment derived from granite—another may have been black, like many streams in the Tyrol, flowing from the waste of decomposing rocks of dark slate—a third may have been colored by ochreous sediment, like the Red River in Louisiana—a fourth, like the Elsa in Tuscany, may have held much carbonate of lime in solution. At first they would each form distinct deposits of sand, gravel, limestone, marl, or other materials; but, after their junction, new chemical combinations and a distinct color would be the result, and the particles, having been conveyed ten, twenty, or a greater number of miles over alluvial plains, would become finer.

As the average size of the transported particles gets smaller, while the force and volume of the main river increases, the newer deposits spread out over a wider area and are therefore more level than the older ones. Initially, there were many independent deltas at the edges of the basin, and their separate deposits were completely different from one another; one might have been filled, like the Arve where it meets the Rhone, with white sand and sediment from granite—another could have been dark, like many streams in the Tyrol, flowing from decomposed rocks of dark slate—a third might be tinged with ochreous sediment, like the Red River in Louisiana—a fourth, like the Elsa in Tuscany, may have had a lot of dissolved carbonate of lime. Initially, they would each create distinct deposits of sand, gravel, limestone, marl, or other materials; but after they merged, there would be new chemical combinations and a unique color would emerge, and the particles, having traveled ten, twenty, or more miles across alluvial plains, would become smaller.

In those deltas where the tides and strong marine currents interfere, the above description would only be applicable, with certain modifications. If a series of earthquakes accompany the growth of a delta, and change the levels of the land from time to time, as in the region where the Indus now enters the sea, the phenomena will depart still more widely from the ordinary type. If, after a protracted period of rest, a delta sinks down, pebbles may be borne along in shallow water near the foot of the boundary hills, so as to form conglomerates overlying the fine mud previously thrown into deeper water in the same area.

In those deltas where tides and strong ocean currents mix, the description above would only apply with some adjustments. If a series of earthquakes occur along with the formation of a delta, changing the land levels from time to time, as happens in the area where the Indus River flows into the sea, the phenomena will diverge even more from the typical pattern. If a delta sinks after a long period of stability, pebbles may be carried along in shallow water near the edge of the hills, forming conglomerates on top of the fine mud that was previously deposited in deeper water in the same area.

Causes of stratification in deltas.—The stratified arrangement, which is observed to prevail so generally in aqueous deposits, is most frequently due to variations in the velocity of running water, which cannot sweep along particles of more than a certain size and weight when moving at a given rate. Hence, as the force of the stream augments or decreases, the materials thrown down in successive layers at particular places are rudely sorted, according to their dimensions, form, and specific gravity. Where this cause has not operated, as where sand, mud, and fragments of rock are conveyed by a glacier, a confused heap of rubbish devoid of all stratification is produced.

Causes of stratification in deltas.—The layered arrangement commonly seen in water deposits is usually caused by changes in the speed of flowing water, which can only carry particles up to a certain size and weight at a specific flow rate. Therefore, as the strength of the current increases or decreases, the materials deposited in layers at certain spots are roughly sorted by their size, shape, and density. In cases where this process does not happen, such as when sand, mud, and rock pieces are transported by a glacier, a mixed pile of debris without any layering is formed.

Natural divisions are also occasioned in deltas, by the interval of time which separates annually the deposition of matter during the periodical rains, or melting of snow upon the mountains. The deposit of each year may acquire some degree of consistency before that of the succeeding year is superimposed. A variety of circumstances also give rise annually, or sometimes from day to day, to slight variations in color, 288 fineness of the particles, and other characters, by which alternations of strata distinct in texture and mineral ingredients must be produced. Thus, for example, at one period of the year, drift-wood may be carried down, and, at another, mud, as was before stated to be the case in the delta of the Mississippi; or at one time, when the volume and velocity of the stream are greatest, pebbles and sand may be spread over a certain area, over which, when the waters are low, fine matter or chemical precipitates are formed. During inundations, the turbid current of fresh water often repels the sea for many miles; but when the river is low, salt water again occupies the same space. When two deltas are converging, the intermediate space is often, for reasons before explained, alternately the receptacle of different sediments derived from the converging streams (see p. 272). The one is, perhaps, charged with calcareous, the other with argillaceous matter; or one sweeps down sand and pebbles, the other impalpable mud. These differences may be repeated with considerable regularity, until a thickness of hundreds of feet of alternating beds is accumulated. The multiplication, also, of shells and corals in particular spots, and for limited periods, gives rise occasionally to lines of separation, and divides a mass which might otherwise be homogeneous into distinct strata.

Natural divisions also occur in deltas due to the time gap each year that separates the deposition of materials during the seasonal rains or the melting snow from the mountains. Each year's deposit may develop some level of consistency before the next year's layer is added on top. Various factors also lead to slight variations in color, particle fineness, and other characteristics on an annual or even daily basis, which results in the formation of distinct strata with different textures and mineral compositions. For instance, at one time of the year, driftwood might be brought down, and at another time, mud, as previously mentioned in relation to the Mississippi delta. Alternatively, when the river's volume and speed are at their peak, pebbles and sand might cover a certain area, which later, when water levels drop, becomes filled with fine materials or chemical deposits. During floods, the murky flow of fresh water often pushes back the sea for several miles; however, when the river is low, saltwater reoccupies the same area. When two deltas meet, the space in between often serves, for reasons discussed earlier, as a repository for various sediments from the merging streams (see p. 272). One delta may carry calcareous materials, while the other may transport clay-rich matter; one might wash down sand and pebbles, while the other brings in fine mud. These differences can occur with substantial regularity, leading to a buildup of hundreds of feet of alternating layers. The increased presence of shells and corals in specific areas and for finite periods can sometimes create lines of separation, which divides a mass that would otherwise be homogeneous into distinct layers.

An examination of the shell marl now forming in the Scotch lakes, or the sediment termed "warp," which subsides from the muddy water of the Humber and other rivers, shows that recent deposits are often composed of a great number of extremely thin layers, either even or slightly undulating, and preserving a general parallelism to the planes of stratification. Sometimes, however, the laminæ in modern strata are disposed diagonally at a considerable angle, which appears to take place where there are conflicting movements in the waters. In January, 1829, I visited, in company with Professor L. A. Necker, of Geneva, the confluence of the Rhone and Arve, when those rivers were very low, and were cutting channels through the vast heaps of débris thrown down from the waters of the Arve in the preceding spring. One of the sandbanks which had formed, in the spring of 1828, where the opposing currents of the two rivers neutralized each other, and caused a retardation in the motion, had been undermined; and the following is an exact representation of the arrangement of laminæ exposed in a vertical section. The length of the portion here seen is about twelve feet, and the height five. The strata A A consist of irregular alternations of pebbles and sand in undulating beds: below these are seams of very fine sand B B, some as thin as paper, others about a quarter of an inch thick. The strata C C are composed of layers of fine greenish-gray sand as thin as paper. Some of the inclined beds will be seen to be thicker at their upper, others at their lower extremity, the inclination of some being very considerable. These layers must have accumulated one on the other by lateral apposition, probably when one of the rivers was very gradually increasing or diminishing in velocity, so that the point of greatest retardation caused by their conflicting currents shifted slowly, 289 allowing the sediment to be thrown down in successive layers on a sloping bank. The same phenomenon is exhibited in older strata of all ages.376

An examination of the shell marl currently forming in the Scottish lakes, or the sediment known as "warp," which settles from the muddy waters of the Humber and other rivers, shows that recent deposits are often made up of a large number of very thin layers, either flat or slightly undulating, and generally maintain a parallel alignment to the stratification planes. However, sometimes the layers in modern strata are arranged diagonally at a significant angle, which seems to occur where there are conflicting water movements. In January 1829, I visited, along with Professor L. A. Necker from Geneva, the point where the Rhone and Arve rivers meet when those rivers were very low and carving channels through the large piles of debris deposited from the Arve's waters in the previous spring. One of the sandbanks that had developed in the spring of 1828, where the opposing currents of the two rivers canceled each other out and caused a slowdown in flow, had been undermined; the following is an exact representation of the arrangement of layers exposed in a vertical section. The length of the part shown here is about twelve feet, and its height is five. The strata A A consist of uneven mixtures of pebbles and sand in rolling beds: beneath these are layers of very fine sand B B, some as thin as paper, others about a quarter of an inch thick. The strata C C are made up of layers of fine greenish-gray sand as thin as paper. Some of the angled beds appear thicker at their upper end, while others are thicker at their lower end, with some having a steep incline. These layers likely accumulated on top of each other through lateral stacking, probably when one of the rivers was gradually increasing or decreasing in speed, so that the point of most significant slowdown caused by their conflicting currents shifted slowly, allowing the sediment to be deposited in successive layers on a sloping bank. This same phenomenon can be observed in older strata from all periods.289

Fig. 26.

Fig. 26.

Section of a sand-bank.

Section of a sand-bank in the bed of the Arve at its confluence with the Rhone, showing the stratification of deposits where currents meet.

Section of a sandbank in the bed of the Arve where it meets the Rhone, showing the layering of deposits where the currents converge.

If the bed of a lake or of the sea be sinking, whether at a uniform or an unequal rate, or oscillating in level during the deposition of sediment, these movements will give rise to a different class of phenomena, as, for example, to repeated alternations of shallow-water and deep-water deposits, each with peculiar organic remains, or to frequent repetitions of similar beds, formed at a uniform depth, and inclosing the same organic remains, and to other results too complicated and varied to admit of enumeration here.

If the bottom of a lake or the sea is sinking, whether at a steady or uneven pace, or rising and falling in level while sediment is being deposited, these movements will lead to a different set of phenomena. This can include repeated shifts between shallow-water and deep-water deposits, each featuring distinct organic remains, or frequent repetitions of similar layers created at a consistent depth, containing the same organic remains, along with other outcomes that are too complex and varied to list here.

Formation of conglomerates.—Along the base of the Maritime Alps, between Toulon and Genoa, the rivers, with few exceptions, are now forming strata of conglomerate and sand. Their channels are often several miles in breadth, some of them being dry, and the rest easily forded for nearly eight months in the year, whereas during the melting of the snow they are swollen, and a great transportation of mud and pebbles takes place. In order to keep open the main road from France to Italy, now carried along the sea-coast, it is necessary to remove annually great masses of shingle brought down during the flood season. A portion of the pebbles are seen in some localities, as near Nice, to form beds of shingle along the shore, but the greater part are swept into a deep sea. The small progress made by the deltas of minor rivers on this coast need not surprise us, when we recollect that there is sometimes a depth of two thousand feet at a few hundred yards from the beach, as near Nice. Similar observations might be made respecting a large proportion of the rivers in Sicily, and among others, respecting that which, immediately north of the port of Messina, hurries annually vast masses of granitic pebbles into the sea.

Formation of conglomerates.—Along the base of the Maritime Alps, between Toulon and Genoa, the rivers, with few exceptions, are currently creating layers of conglomerate and sand. Their channels are often several miles wide, with some being dry and others easily crossed for nearly eight months of the year. However, during the snowmelt, they swell, leading to a significant transport of mud and pebbles. To keep the main road open from France to Italy, which runs along the coastline, it’s necessary to remove large amounts of shingle brought down during the flood season every year. Some pebbles can be seen forming shingle beds along the shore in certain areas, like near Nice, but most are washed out into deeper water. The slow progress of the deltas formed by smaller rivers along this coast shouldn’t surprise us, considering that there can be depths of two thousand feet just a few hundred yards from the beach, as seen near Nice. Similar observations can be made about many rivers in Sicily, including one just north of the port of Messina, which rushes vast amounts of granitic pebbles into the sea each year.

Constant interchange of land and sea.—I may here conclude my remarks on deltas, observing that, imperfect as is our information of the changes which they have undergone within the last three thousand years, they are sufficient to show how constant an interchange of sea 290 and land is taking place on the face of our globe. In the Mediterranean alone, many flourishing inland towns, and a still greater number of ports, now stand where the sea rolled its waves since the era of the early civilization of Europe. If we could compare with equal accuracy the ancient and actual state of all the islands and continents, we should probably discover that millions of our race are now supported by lands situated where deep seas prevailed in earlier ages. In many districts not yet occupied by man, land animals and forests now abound where ships once sailed; and, on the other hand, we shall find, on inquiry, that inroads of the ocean have been no less considerable. When to these revolutions, produced by aqueous causes, we add analogous changes wrought by igneous agency, we shall, perhaps, acknowledge the justice of the conclusion of Aristotle, who declared that the whole land and sea on our globe periodically changed places.377

Constant interchange of land and sea.—I can conclude my thoughts on deltas by noting that, although our knowledge of the changes they've undergone over the last three thousand years is incomplete, it’s enough to demonstrate how consistently land and sea are exchanging places on our planet. In the Mediterranean alone, many prosperous inland towns and even more ports now exist where the sea once rolled its waves since the dawn of early European civilization. If we could accurately compare the past and present states of all islands and continents, we would probably find that millions of people today live on lands that were once deep under the sea in earlier times. In many areas still untouched by humans, land animals and forests now thrive in spots where ships used to navigate; conversely, we find that encroachment by the ocean has been equally significant. When we consider these changes caused by water, along with similar transformations brought about by volcanic activity, we might agree with Aristotle’s conclusion that the entire land and sea on our planet occasionally swap places.377


CHAPTER XIX.

DESTROYING AND TRANSPORTING EFFECTS OF TIDES AND CURRENTS.

Difference in the rise of tides—Lagullas and Gulf currents—Velocity of currents—Causes of currents—Action of the sea on the British coast—Shetland Islands—Large blocks removed—Isles reduced to clusters of rocks—Orkney isles—Waste of East coast of Scotland—and East coast of England—Waste of the cliffs of Holderness, Norfolk, and Suffolk—Sand-dunes, how far chronometers—Silting up of estuaries—Yarmouth estuary—Suffolk coast—Dunwich—Essex coast—Estuary of the Thames—Goodwin Sands—Coast of Kent—Formation of the Straits of Dover—South coast of England—Sussex—Hants—Dorset—Portland—Origin of the Chesil Bank—Cornwall—Coast of Brittany.

Difference in the rise of tides—Lagullas and Gulf currents—Velocity of currents—Causes of currents—Action of the sea on the British coast—Shetland Islands—Large blocks removed—Isles reduced to clusters of rocks—Orkney isles—Erosion of the East coast of Scotland—and East coast of England—Erosion of the cliffs of Holderness, Norfolk, and Suffolk—Sand-dunes, how far chronometers—Silting up of estuaries—Yarmouth estuary—Suffolk coast—Dunwich—Essex coast—Estuary of the Thames—Goodwin Sands—Coast of Kent—Formation of the Straits of Dover—South coast of England—Sussex—Hampshire—Dorset—Portland—Origin of the Chesil Bank—Cornwall—Coast of Brittany.

Although the movements of great bodies of water, termed tides and currents, are in general due to very distinct causes, their effects cannot be studied separately; for they produce, by their joint action, aided by that of the waves, those changes which are objects of geological interest. These forces may be viewed in the same manner as we before considered rivers, first, as employed in destroying portions of the solid crust of the earth and removing them to other places; secondly, as reproductive of new strata.

Although the movements of large bodies of water, known as tides and currents, generally have very different causes, their effects can't be studied separately. Together, along with the waves, they create changes that are significant in geology. We can look at these forces in the same way we previously examined rivers: first, as they break down parts of the earth's solid crust and transport them elsewhere; second, as they contribute to the formation of new layers.

Tides.—It would be superfluous at the present day to offer any remarks on the cause of the tides. They are not perceptible in lakes or in most inland seas; in the Mediterranean even, deep and extensive as is that sea, they are scarcely sensible to ordinary observation, their effects being quite subordinate to those of the winds and currents. In some places, however, as in the Straits of Messina, there is an ebb and flow to the amount of two feet and upwards; at Naples and at the 291 Euripus, of twelve or thirteen inches; and at Venice, according to Rennell, of five feet.378 In the Syrtes, also, of the ancients, two wide shallow gulfs, which penetrate very far within the northern coast of Africa, between Carthage and Cyrene, the rise is said to exceed five feet.379

Tides.—Today, it would be unnecessary to discuss the cause of tides. They aren’t noticeable in lakes or most inland seas; even in the Mediterranean, which is deep and vast, they’re hardly detectable to casual observation, as their effects are quite minor compared to those of the winds and currents. However, in certain places, like the Straits of Messina, there is a noticeable ebb and flow of two feet or more; at Naples and the 291 Euripus, it’s about twelve or thirteen inches; and at Venice, according to Rennell, it’s around five feet.378 In the Syrtes, as noted by the ancients, there are two wide shallow bays that extend far into the northern coast of Africa between Carthage and Cyrene, where the rise is said to be over five feet.379

In islands remote from any continent, the ebb and flow of the ocean is very slight, as at St. Helena, for example, where it is rarely above three feet.380 In any given line of coast, the tides are greatest in narrow channels, bays, and estuaries, and least in the intervening tracts where the land is prominent. Thus, at the entrance of the estuary of the Thames and Medway, the rise of the spring tides is eighteen feet; but when we follow our eastern coast from thence northward, towards Lowestoff and Yarmouth, we find a gradual diminution, until at the places last mentioned, the highest rise is only seven or eight feet. From this point there begins again to be an increase, so that at Comer, where the coast again retires towards the west, the rise is sixteen feet; and towards the extremity of the gulf called "the Wash," as at Lynn and in Boston Deeps, it is from twenty-two to twenty-four feet, and in some extraordinary cases twenty-six feet. From thence again there is a decrease towards, the north, the elevation at the Spurn Point being from nineteen to twenty feet, and at Flamborough Head and the Yorkshire coast from fourteen to sixteen feet.381

In islands far from any continent, the rise and fall of the ocean is very minimal, like at St. Helena, where it rarely exceeds three feet.380 Along any stretch of coast, the tides are highest in narrow channels, bays, and estuaries, and lowest in the areas where the land is more prominent. For instance, at the entrance of the Thames and Medway estuary, spring tides rise by eighteen feet; however, if we follow the eastern coast northward towards Lowestoft and Yarmouth, we notice a gradual decrease, with the highest rise only reaching seven or eight feet at those locations. After that, the tide starts to increase again, so at Comer, where the coast curves back toward the west, the rise is sixteen feet. Toward the end of the bay known as "the Wash," such as in Lynn and Boston Deeps, it can range from twenty-two to twenty-four feet, and in some exceptional cases, even twenty-six feet. After that, there’s another decrease moving north, with the height at Spurn Point reaching nineteen to twenty feet, and at Flamborough Head and the Yorkshire coast, the rise is between fourteen to sixteen feet.381

At Milford Haven in Pembrokeshire, at the mouth of the Bristol Channel, the tides rise thirty-six feet; and at King-Road near Bristol, forty-two feet. At Chepstow on the Wye, a small river which opens into the estuary of the Severn, they reach fifty feet, and sometimes sixty-nine, and even seventy-two feet. A current which sets in on the French coast, to the west of Cape La Hague, becomes pent up by Guernsey, Jersey, and other islands, till the rise of the tide is from twenty to forty-five feet, which last height it attains at Jersey, and at St. Malo, a seaport of Brittany. The tides in the Basin of Mines, at the head of the Bay of Fundy in Nova Scotia, rise to the height of seventy feet.

At Milford Haven in Pembrokeshire, where the Bristol Channel meets the sea, the tides rise thirty-six feet; and at King-Road near Bristol, they reach forty-two feet. At Chepstow on the Wye, a small river that flows into the Severn estuary, the tides can rise to fifty feet, sometimes even reaching sixty-nine or seventy-two feet. A current that originates off the French coast, west of Cape La Hague, gets trapped by Guernsey, Jersey, and other islands, causing the tide there to rise between twenty and forty-five feet, with the highest being at Jersey and St. Malo, a port in Brittany. In the Basin of Mines, at the head of the Bay of Fundy in Nova Scotia, the tides can rise to seventy feet.

There are, however, some coasts where the tides seem to offer an exception to the rule above mentioned; for while there is scarcely any rise in the estuary of the Plata in S. America, there is an extremely high tide on the open coast of Patagonia, farther to the south. Yet even in this region the tides reach their greatest elevation (about fifty feet) in the Straits of Magellan, and so far at least they conform to the general rule.382

There are, however, some coasts where the tides seem to break the mentioned rule; while there is hardly any rise in the estuary of the Plata in South America, there is a very high tide on the open coast of Patagonia, further south. Yet even in this area, the tides reach their highest point (about fifty feet) in the Straits of Magellan, and at least in this case, they follow the general rule.382

Currents.—The most extensive and best determined system of currents, is that which has its source in the Indian Ocean under the influence of the trade winds; and which, after doubling the Cape of Good 292 Hope, inclines to the northward, along the western coast of Africa, then across the Atlantic, near the equator, where it is called the equatorial current, and is lost in the Caribbean Sea, yet seems to be again revived in the current which issues from the Gulf of Mexico. From thence it flows rapidly through the Straits of Bahama, taking the name of the Gulf Stream, and passing in a northeasterly direction, by the Banks of Newfoundland, towards the Azores.

Currents.—The most extensive and well-understood system of currents originates in the Indian Ocean, influenced by the trade winds. After rounding the Cape of Good 292 Hope, it moves northward along the western coast of Africa, then across the Atlantic near the equator, where it’s known as the equatorial current, eventually dissipating in the Caribbean Sea but seeming to re-emerge in the current that flows out of the Gulf of Mexico. From there, it swiftly travels through the Straits of Bahama, taking on the name Gulf Stream, and continues in a northeastern direction past the Banks of Newfoundland toward the Azores.

We learn from the posthumous work of Rennell on this subject, that the Lagullas current, so called from the cape and bank of that name, is formed by the junction of two streams, flowing from the Indian Ocean; the one from the channel of Mozambique, down the southeast coast of Africa; the other from the ocean at large. The collective stream is from ninety to one hundred miles in breadth, and runs at the rate of from two and a half to more than four miles per hour. It is at length turned westward by the Lagullas bank, which rises from a sea of great depth to within one hundred fathoms of the surface. It must therefore be inferred, says Rennell, that the current here is more than one hundred fathoms deep, otherwise the main body of it would pass across the bank, instead of being deflected westward, so as to flow round the Cape of Good Hope. From this cape it flows northward, as before stated, along the western coast of Africa, taking the name of the South Atlantic current. It then enters the Bight, or Bay of Benin, and is turned westward, partly by the form of the coast there, and partly, perhaps, by the Guinea current, which runs from the north into the same great bay. From the centre of this bay proceeds the equatorial current already mentioned, holding a westerly direction across the Atlantic, which it traverses, from the coast of Guinea to that of Brazil, flowing afterwards by the shores of Guiana to the West Indies. The breadth of this current varies from 160 to 450 geographical miles, and its velocity is from twenty-five to seventy-nine miles per day, the mean rate being about thirty miles. The length of its whole course is about 4000 miles. As it skirts the coast of Guiana, it is increased by the influx of the waters of the Amazon and Orinoco, and by their junction acquires accelerated velocity. After passing the island of Trinidad it expands, and is almost lost in the Caribbean Sea; but there appears to be a general movement of that sea towards the Mexican Gulf, which discharges the most powerful of all currents through the Straits of Florida, where the waters run in the northern part with a velocity of four or five miles an hour, having a breadth of from thirty-five to fifty miles.383

We learn from Rennell's posthumous work on this topic that the Lagullas current, named after the cape and bank of the same name, is created by the merging of two streams flowing from the Indian Ocean. One stream comes from the Mozambique Channel, flowing down the southeast coast of Africa, while the other comes from the wider ocean. Together, the stream spans from ninety to one hundred miles in width and flows at a speed of two and a half to over four miles per hour. Eventually, it is diverted westward by the Lagullas bank, which rises from a deep sea to within one hundred fathoms of the surface. Rennell concludes that the current here must be more than one hundred fathoms deep; otherwise, the main body of water would flow across the bank instead of being deflected westward to flow around the Cape of Good Hope. From this cape, it continues northward, as mentioned earlier, along the western coast of Africa, taking on the name of the South Atlantic current. It then enters the Bight, or Bay of Benin, where it is redirected westward, partly due to the shape of the coast there, and possibly influenced by the Guinea current, which flows from the north into the same large bay. From the center of this bay, the previously mentioned equatorial current flows westward across the Atlantic, moving from the coast of Guinea to Brazil, and then flows by the shores of Guiana to the West Indies. The width of this current ranges from 160 to 450 geographical miles, with a speed of twenty-five to seventy-nine miles per day, averaging around thirty miles. The total length of its course is about 4000 miles. As it approaches the Guiana coast, it is augmented by the inflow of the Amazon and Orinoco rivers, which increases its speed. After passing the island of Trinidad, it expands and nearly disappears into the Caribbean Sea; however, there seems to be a general movement of that sea towards the Gulf of Mexico, which releases the strongest current of all through the Straits of Florida, where the waters flow in the northern part at a speed of four or five miles an hour, with a width of thirty-five to fifty miles.383

The temperature of the Gulf of Mexico is 86° F. in summer, or 6° higher than that of the ocean, in the same parallel (25° N. lat.), and a large proportion of this warmth is retained, even where the stream reaches the 43° N. lat. After issuing from the Straits of Florida, the current runs in a northerly direction to Cape Hatteras, in North Carolina, about 35° N. lat., where it is more than seventy miles broad, and 293 still moves at the rate of seventy-five miles per day. In about the 40° N. lat., it is turned more towards the Atlantic by the extensive banks of Nantucket and St. George, which are from 200 to 300 feet beneath the surface of the sea; a clear proof that the current exceeds that depth. On arriving near the Azores, the stream widens, and overflows, as it were, forming a large expanse of warm water in the centre of the North Atlantic, over a space of 200 or 300 miles from north to south, and having a temperature of from 8° to 10° Fahr. above the surrounding ocean. The whole area, covered by the Gulf water, is estimated by Rennell at 2000 miles in length, and, at a mean, 350 miles in breadth; an area more extensive than that of the Mediterranean. The warm water has been sometimes known to reach the Bay of Biscay, still retaining five degrees of temperature above that of the adjoining ocean; and a branch of the Gulf current occasionally drifts fruits, plants, and wood, the produce of America and the West Indies, to the shores of Ireland and the Hebrides.

The Gulf of Mexico's temperature hits 86° F in the summer, which is 6° higher than the ocean at the same latitude (25° N). A lot of this warmth stays, even when the current reaches 43° N. After flowing out of the Straits of Florida, the current travels north to Cape Hatteras in North Carolina, around 35° N, where it spreads over more than seventy miles and moves at about seventy-five miles per day. At around 40° N, it shifts more towards the Atlantic due to the extensive banks of Nantucket and St. George, which lie between 200 to 300 feet beneath the sea's surface—a clear sign that the current is deeper than that. As the current approaches the Azores, it widens and spills over, creating a large area of warm water in the center of the North Atlantic, spanning 200 to 300 miles from north to south, with temperatures 8° to 10° F higher than the surrounding ocean. According to Rennell, the entire area covered by Gulf water stretches about 2000 miles in length and averages 350 miles in breadth, which is larger than the Mediterranean Sea. This warm water has sometimes been known to reach the Bay of Biscay, still maintaining a temperature five degrees above the adjacent ocean; plus, a branch of the Gulf current occasionally carries fruits, plants, and wood from America and the West Indies to the coasts of Ireland and the Hebrides.

From the above statements we may understand why Rennell has characterized some of the principal currents as oceanic rivers, which he describes as being from 50 to 250 miles in breadth, and having a rapidity exceeding that of the largest navigable rivers of the continents, and so deep as to be sometimes obstructed, and occasionally turned aside, by banks, the tops of which do not rise within forty, fifty, or even one hundred fathoms of the surface of the sea.384

From the statements above, we can see why Rennell referred to some of the main currents as oceanic rivers. He describes them as being 50 to 250 miles wide, flowing faster than the largest navigable rivers on land, and so deep that they can sometimes be blocked or even redirected by banks that are at least forty, fifty, or even one hundred fathoms below the surface of the sea.384

Greatest velocity of currents.—The ordinary velocity of the principal currents of the ocean is from one to three miles per hour; but when the boundary lands converge, large bodies of water are driven gradually into a narrow space, and then wanting lateral room, are compelled to raise their level. Whenever this occurs their velocity is much increased. The current which runs through the Race of Alderney, between the island of that name and the main land, has a velocity of about eight English miles an hour. Captain Hewett found that in the Pentland Firth, the stream, in ordinary spring tides, runs ten miles and a half an hour, and about thirteen miles during violent storms. The greatest velocity of the tidal current through the "Shoots" or New Passage, in the Bristol Channel, is fourteen English miles an hour; and Captain King observed, in his survey of the Straits of Magellan, that the tide ran at the same rate through the "First Narrows," and about eight geographical miles an hour, in other parts of those straits.

Greatest velocity of currents.—The usual speed of the main ocean currents ranges from one to three miles per hour; however, when coastal areas come together, large volumes of water are gradually pushed into a narrower space, and lacking lateral room, they are forced to rise. When this happens, their speed significantly increases. The current that flows through the Race of Alderney, between that island and the mainland, travels at about eight miles per hour. Captain Hewett found that in the Pentland Firth, the current during ordinary spring tides runs at ten and a half miles per hour, and about thirteen miles during severe storms. The highest speed of the tidal current through the "Shoots" or New Passage in the Bristol Channel reaches fourteen miles per hour; and Captain King noted in his survey of the Straits of Magellan that the tide flowed at the same speed through the "First Narrows," and about eight geographical miles per hour in other areas of those straits.

Causes of currents.—That movements of no inconsiderable magnitude should be impressed on an expansive ocean, by winds blowing for many months in one direction, may easily be conceived, when we observe the effects produced in our own seas by the temporary action of the same cause. It is well known that a strong southwest or northwest wind invariably raises the tides to an unusual height along the west coast of England and in the Channel; and that a northwest wind 294 of any continuance causes the Baltic to rise two feet and upwards above its ordinary level. Smeaton ascertained by experiment, that in a canal four miles in length, the water was kept up four inches higher at one end than at the other, merely by the action of the wind along the canal; and Rennell informs us that a large piece of water, ten miles broad, and generally only three feet deep, has, by a strong wind, had its waters driven to one side, and sustained so as to become six feet deep, while the windward side was laid dry.385

Causes of currents.—It's easy to understand how significant movements can be created in a vast ocean by winds blowing for months in the same direction, especially when we notice the effects seen in our own seas from the temporary influence of the same cause. It's well known that a strong southwest or northwest wind consistently raises the tides unusually high along the west coast of England and in the Channel; and that a continuous northwest wind can cause the Baltic Sea to rise two feet or more above its normal level. Smeaton discovered through experimentation that in a canal four miles long, the water was kept four inches higher at one end than the other simply due to the wind blowing along the canal; and Rennell tells us that a large body of water, ten miles wide and generally only three feet deep, can have its waters pushed to one side by a strong wind, making that side six feet deep, while the opposite side gets dried up.385

As water, therefore, he observes, when pent up so that it cannot escape, acquires a higher level, so, in a place where it can escape, the same operation produces a current; and this current will extend to a greater or less distance, according to the force by which it is produced. By the side of the principal oceanic currents, such as the Lagullas and the Gulf Stream, are parallel "counter-currents" running steadily in an opposite direction.

As water, he notes, when trapped so that it can't flow out, rises to a higher level; similarly, in a place where it can flow out, the same process creates a current. This current will travel varying distances, depending on the strength that creates it. Alongside the main ocean currents, like the Agulhas and the Gulf Stream, there are parallel "counter-currents" that flow steadily in the opposite direction.

Currents flowing alternately in opposite directions are occasioned by the rise and fall of the tides. The effect of this cause is, as before observed, most striking in estuaries and channels between islands.

Currents that flow back and forth in opposite directions are caused by the rise and fall of the tides. The impact of this is, as noted earlier, particularly noticeable in estuaries and the channels between islands.

A third cause of oceanic currents is evaporation by solar heat, of which the great current setting through the Straits of Gibraltar into the Mediterranean is a remarkable example, and will be fully considered in the next chapter. A stream of colder water also flows from the Black Sea into the Mediterranean. It must happen in many other parts of the world that large quantities of water raised from one tract of the ocean by solar heat, are carried to some other where the vapor is condensed and falls in the shape of rain, and this, in flowing back again to restore equilibrium, will cause sensible currents.

A third reason for ocean currents is evaporation due to solar heat. A notable example of this is the significant current flowing through the Straits of Gibraltar into the Mediterranean, which will be discussed in detail in the next chapter. Additionally, a stream of colder water flows from the Black Sea into the Mediterranean. It's likely that in many other areas of the world, large amounts of water evaporated from one part of the ocean by solar heat are transported to another area, where the vapor condenses and falls as rain. This process, as the water flows back to restore balance, creates noticeable currents.

These considerations naturally lead to the inquiry whether the level of those seas out of which currents flow, is higher than that of seas into which they flow. If not, the effect must be immediately equalized by under-currents or counter-currents. Arago is of opinion that, so far as observations have gone, there are no exact proofs of any such difference of level. It was inferred from the measurements of M. Lepére, that the level of the Mediterranean, near Alexandria, was lower by 26 feet 6 inches, than the Red Sea near Suez at low water, and about 30 feet lower than the Red Sea at the same place at high water,386 but Mr. Robert Stevenson affirms, as the result of a more recent survey, that there is no difference of level between the two seas.387

These considerations naturally lead to the question of whether the level of the seas that currents flow out of is higher than the level of the seas that they flow into. If not, the effect must be immediately balanced by undercurrents or countercurrents. Arago believes that, based on available observations, there is no solid evidence of any such difference in level. From the measurements taken by M. Lepére, it was concluded that the level of the Mediterranean near Alexandria is 26 feet 6 inches lower than that of the Red Sea near Suez at low water, and about 30 feet lower than the Red Sea at the same location at high water,386 but Mr. Robert Stevenson states, based on a more recent survey, that there is no difference in level between the two seas.387

It was formerly imagined that there was an equal, if not greater, diversity in the relative levels of the Atlantic and Pacific, on the opposite sides of the Isthmus of Panama. But the levellings carried across that isthmus by Capt. Lloyd, in 1828, to ascertain the relative height of the Pacific Ocean at Panama, and of the Atlantic at the mouth of the river Chagres, have shown, that the difference of mean level between 295 those oceans is not considerable, and, contrary to expectation, the difference which does exist is in favor of the greater height of the Pacific. According to this survey, the mean height of the Pacific is three feet and a half, or 3·52 above the Atlantic, if we assume the mean level of a sea to coincide with the mean between the extremes of the elevation and depression of the tides; for between the extreme levels of the greatest tides in the Pacific, at Panama, there is a difference of 27·44 feet; and at the usual spring tides 21·22 feet; whereas at Chagres this difference is only 1·16 feet, and is the same at all seasons of the year.

It was previously thought that there was an equal, if not greater, difference in the relative levels of the Atlantic and Pacific Oceans on either side of the Isthmus of Panama. However, the surveys conducted across that isthmus by Captain Lloyd in 1828, aimed at determining the relative height of the Pacific Ocean at Panama and the Atlantic at the mouth of the Chagres River, revealed that the mean level difference between those oceans is not significant. Contrary to expectations, the existing difference actually shows that the Pacific is at a higher level. According to this survey, the Pacific's average height is three and a half feet, or 3.52, above the Atlantic if we consider the average sea level to be the midpoint between the highest and lowest tide levels. The extreme levels of the highest tides in the Pacific at Panama show a difference of 27.44 feet, and during typical spring tides, it's 21.22 feet. In contrast, at Chagres, this difference is only 1.16 feet and remains consistent throughout the year.

The tides, in short, in the Caribbean Sea are scarcely perceptible, not equalling those in some parts of the Mediterranean, whereas the rise is very high in the Bay of Panama; so that the Pacific is at high tide lifted up several feet above the surface of the Gulf of Mexico, and then at low water let down as far below it.388 But astronomers are agreed that, on mathematical principles, the rise of the tidal wave above the mean level of a particular sea must be greater than the fall below it; and although the difference has been hitherto supposed insufficient to cause an appreciable error, it is, nevertheless, worthy of observation, that the error, such as it may be, would tend to reduce the small difference, now inferred, from the observations of Mr. Lloyd, to exist between the levels of the two oceans.

The tides in the Caribbean Sea are hardly noticeable, not matching those found in some areas of the Mediterranean. However, the rise is quite significant in the Bay of Panama; the Pacific is raised several feet above the surface of the Gulf of Mexico at high tide and then lowered several feet below it at low tide.388 Astronomers agree that, based on mathematical principles, the rise of the tidal wave above the average level of a specific sea must be greater than the drop below it. Although the difference has been previously considered too small to cause a significant error, it is still important to note that any error, however minor, would likely reduce the slight difference suggested by Mr. Lloyd's observations regarding the levels of the two oceans.

There is still another way in which heat and cold must occasion great movements in the ocean, a cause to which, perhaps, currents are principally due. Whenever the temperature of the surface of the sea is lowered, condensation takes place, and the superficial water, having its specific gravity increased, falls to the bottom, upon which lighter water rises immediately and occupies its place. When this circulation of ascending and descending currents has gone on for a certain time in high latitudes, the inferior parts of the sea are made to consist of colder or heavier fluid than the corresponding depths of the ocean between the tropics. If there be a free communication, if no chain of submarine mountains divide the polar from the equatorial basins, a horizontal movement will arise by the flowing of colder water from the poles to the equator, and there will then be a reflux of warmer superficial water from the equator to the poles. A well-known experiment has been adduced to elucidate this mode of action in explanation of the "trade winds."389 If a long trough, divided in the middle by a sluice or partition, have one end filled with water and the other with quicksilver, both fluids will remain quiet so long as they are divided; but when the sluice is drawn up, the heavier fluid will rush along the bottom of the trough, while the lighter, being displaced, will rise, and, flowing in an opposite direction, spread itself at the top. In like manner the expansion and contraction of sea-water by heat and cold, have a tendency to set under-currents 296 in motion from the poles to the equator, and to cause counter-currents at the surface, which are impelled in a direction contrary to that of the prevailing trade winds. The geographical and other circumstances being very complicated, we cannot expect to trace separately the movements due to each cause, but must be prepared for many anomalies, especially as the configuration of the bed of the ocean must often modify and interfere with the course of the inferior currents, as much as the position and form of continents and islands alter the direction of those on the surface. Thus on sounding at great depths in the Mediterranean, Captains Berard and D'Urville have found that the cold does not increase in a high ratio as in the tropical regions of the ocean, the thermometer remaining fixed at about 55° F. between the depths of 1000 and 6000 feet. This might have been anticipated, as Captain Smyth in his survey had shown that the deepest part of the Straits of Gibraltar is only 1320 feet, so that a submarine barrier exists there which must prevent the influx of any under-current of the ocean cooled by polar ice.

There’s another way that heat and cold cause significant movements in the ocean, possibly leading to currents. Whenever the surface temperature of the sea drops, condensation occurs, and the denser water sinks to the bottom, allowing lighter water to rise and take its place. After a while of these rising and sinking currents in high latitudes, the lower parts of the sea become colder or heavier than the depths of the ocean between the tropics. If there’s free communication and no underwater mountain chain separating the polar and equatorial basins, a horizontal movement happens as the colder water flows from the poles to the equator, while warmer surface water moves back from the equator to the poles. A well-known experiment demonstrates this process with the "trade winds."389 If you have a long trough divided in the middle by a sluice or partition, with one end filled with water and the other with mercury, both liquids will stay still as long as they’re separated. But when the sluice is opened, the heavier liquid rushes along the bottom of the trough, while the lighter liquid, being displaced, rises and flows in the opposite direction at the top. Similarly, the expansion and contraction of seawater due to heat and cold tend to create undercurrents flowing from the poles to the equator, causing surface counter-currents that move in the opposite direction of the prevailing trade winds. Since the geographical and other factors are complex, we can’t expect to trace the movements caused by each factor separately, and we should be ready for many anomalies, especially since the ocean floor's shape can modify and interfere with the undercurrents, just as the position and shape of continents and islands change the direction of surface currents. For example, when taking measurements at great depths in the Mediterranean, Captains Berard and D'Urville found that the cold doesn't increase as significantly as in the tropical regions of the ocean, with the thermometer remaining steady at around 55°F between depths of 1000 and 6000 feet. This was expected, as Captain Smyth’s survey showed that the deepest part of the Straits of Gibraltar is only 1320 feet, indicating a submarine barrier that prevents the incoming undercurrent from the ocean cooled by polar ice.

Each of the four causes above mentioned, the wind, the tides, evaporation, and the expansion and contraction of water by heat and cold, may be conceived to operate independently of the others, and although the influence of all the rest were annihilated. But there is another cause, the rotation of the earth on its axis, which can only come into play when the waters have already been set in motion by some one or all of the forces above described, and when the direction of the current so raised happens to be from south to north, or from north to south.

Each of the four causes mentioned above—the wind, the tides, evaporation, and the expansion and contraction of water due to heat and cold—can be considered to work independently from one another, even if the impact of all the others were completely removed. However, there is another cause: the rotation of the earth on its axis. This factor only comes into play once the waters have already been set in motion by one or all of the previously described forces, and when the direction of the current that has been generated happens to be from south to north or from north to south.

The principle on which this cause operates is probably familiar to the reader, as it has long been recognized in the case of the trade winds. Without enlarging, therefore, on the theory, it will be sufficient to offer an example of the mode of action alluded to. When a current flows from the Cape of Good Hope towards the Gulf of Guinea, it consists of a mass of water, which, on doubling the Cape, in lat. 35°, has a rotatory velocity of about 800 miles an hour; but when it reaches the line, where it turns westward, it has arrived at a parallel where the surface of the earth is whirled round at the rate of 1000 miles an hour, or about 200 miles faster. If this great mass of water was transferred suddenly from the higher to the lower latitude, the deficiency of its rotatory motion, relatively to the land and water with which it would come into juxtaposition, would be such as to cause an apparent motion of the most rapid kind (of no less than 200 miles an hour) from east to west.

The principle behind this phenomenon is likely familiar to the reader, as it has been well-established in the context of trade winds. Without going into detail about the theory, it will suffice to provide an example of the described action. When a current flows from the Cape of Good Hope toward the Gulf of Guinea, it consists of a mass of water that, after passing the Cape at latitude 35°, has a rotational speed of about 800 miles an hour. However, when it reaches the equator, where it turns west, it arrives at a latitude where the earth's surface spins at 1000 miles an hour, which is about 200 miles faster. If this large mass of water were suddenly moved from the higher latitude to the lower one, the difference in its rotational speed compared to the land and water it encounters would create an apparent movement of an extremely rapid nature—specifically, a motion of no less than 200 miles an hour from east to west.

In the case of such a sudden transfer, the eastern coast of America, being carried round in an opposite direction, might strike against a large body of water with tremendous violence, and a considerable part of the continent might be submerged. This disturbance does not occur, because the water of the stream, as it advances gradually into new zones of the sea which are moving more rapidly, acquires by friction an accelerated 297 velocity. Yet as this motion is not imparted instantaneously, the fluid is unable to keep up with the full speed of the new surface over which it is successively brought. Hence, to borrow the language of Herschel, when he speaks of the trade winds, "it lags or hangs back, in a direction opposite to the earth's rotation, that is, from east to west,"390 and thus a current, which would have run simply towards the north but for the rotation, may acquire a relative direction towards the west.

In a sudden transfer like this, the eastern coast of America, moving in the opposite direction, could slam into a huge body of water with incredible force, potentially submerging a significant part of the land. This doesn't happen because as the water flows into new areas of the sea, which are moving faster, it gains speed through friction. However, since this motion doesn’t happen all at once, the water can’t match the full speed of the new surface it moves over. So, to quote Herschel when he talks about the trade winds, "it lags or hangs back, in a direction opposite to the earth's rotation, that is, from east to west," and as a result, a current that would have simply flowed north, ends up moving relative to the west. 297

We may next consider a case where the circumstances are the converse of the above. The Gulf Stream flowing from about lat. 20° is at first impressed with a velocity of rotation of about 940 miles an hour, and runs to the lat. 40°, where the earth revolves only at the rate of 766 miles, or 174 miles slower. In this case a relative motion of an opposite kind may result; and the current may retain an excess of rotatory velocity, tending continually to deflect it eastward. Polar currents, therefore, or those flowing from high to low latitudes, are driven towards the eastern shores of continents, while tropical currents flowing towards the poles are directed against their western shores.

We can now look at a situation where the conditions are the opposite of the one we just discussed. The Gulf Stream, starting around latitude 20°, initially moves at a rotational speed of about 940 miles per hour. It continues to latitude 40°, where the Earth only rotates at 766 miles per hour, which is 174 miles slower. In this scenario, a different type of relative motion can occur; the current might maintain a higher rotational speed, which would continuously push it eastward. As a result, polar currents, or those moving from high to low latitudes, are directed toward the eastern shores of continents, while tropical currents heading toward the poles are pushed against their western shores.

Thus it will be seen that currents depend, like the tides, on no temporary or accidental circumstances, but on the laws which preside over the motions of the heavenly bodies. But although the sum of their influence in altering the surface of the earth may be very constant throughout successive epochs, yet the points where these operations are displayed in fullest energy shift perpetually. The height to which the tides rise, and the violence and velocity of currents, depend in a great measure on the actual configuration of the land, the contour of a long line of continental or insular coast, the depth and breadth of channels, the peculiar form of the bottom of seas—in a word, on a combination of circumstances which are made to vary continually by many igneous and aqueous causes, and, amongst the rest, by the tides and currents themselves. Although these agents, therefore, of decay and reproduction are local in reference to periods of short duration, such as those which history embraces, they are nevertheless universal, if we extend our views to a sufficient lapse of ages.

So, it will be clear that currents, like tides, rely not on temporary or random circumstances, but on the laws governing the movements of celestial bodies. While the overall effect of these influences on changing the earth's surface may remain consistent over different eras, the specific locations where these processes show their strongest effects shift continuously. The height of the tides and the strength and speed of currents are largely determined by the actual shape of the land, the outline of coastlines, the depth and width of waterways, and the unique features of the sea floor—in short, by a combination of factors that are constantly changing due to various volcanic and water-related causes, including the tides and currents themselves. Although these factors of erosion and renewal are localized in relation to short timeframes, like those covered by history, they are still universal when we consider a long enough stretch of time.

Destroying and transporting power of currents.—After these preliminary remarks on the nature and causes of currents, their velocity and direction, we may next consider their action on the solid materials of the earth. We shall find that their efforts are, in many respects, strictly analogous to those of rivers. I have already treated in the third chapter, of the manner in which currents sometimes combine with ice, in carrying mud, pebbles, and large fragments of rock to great distances. Their operations are more concealed from our view than those of rivers, but extend over wider areas, and are therefore of more geological importance.

Destroying and transporting power of currents.—After these initial remarks about the nature and causes of currents, along with their speed and direction, we can now examine their impact on the solid materials of the earth. We'll discover that their effects are, in many ways, quite similar to those of rivers. I've already discussed in the third chapter how currents sometimes work with ice to transport mud, pebbles, and large rock fragments over great distances. Their actions are less visible than those of rivers, but they cover larger areas and are therefore more significant in terms of geology.

Waste of the British coasts.Shetland Islands.—If we follow the 298 eastern and southern shores of the British islands, from our Ultima Thule in Shetland to the Land's End in Cornwall, we shall find evidence of a series of changes since the historical era, very illustrative of the kind and degree of force exerted by tides and currents co-operating with the waves of the sea. In this survey we shall have an opportunity of tracing their joint power on islands, promontories, bays, and estuaries; on bold, lofty cliffs, as well as on low shores; and on every description of rock and soil, from granite to blown sand.

Waste of the British coasts.Shetland Islands.—If we follow the 298 eastern and southern shores of the British islands, from our furthest point in Shetland to Land's End in Cornwall, we will find evidence of a series of changes since the historical era, which clearly shows the kind and degree of force exerted by tides and currents working together with the waves of the sea. In this survey, we will have the chance to trace their combined influence on islands, headlands, bays, and estuaries; on steep, towering cliffs as well as on low shores; and on every type of rock and soil, from granite to loose sand.

The northernmost group of the British islands, the Shetland, are composed of a great variety of rocks, including granite, gneiss, mica-slate, serpentine, greenstone, and many others, with some secondary rocks, chiefly sandstone and conglomerate. These islands are exposed continually to the uncontrolled violence of the Atlantic, for no land intervenes between their western shores and America. The prevalence, therefore, of strong westerly gales, causes the waves to be sometimes driven with irresistible force upon the coast, while there is also a current setting from the north. The spray of the sea aids the decomposition of the rocks, and prepares them to be breached by the mechanical force of the waves. Steep cliffs are hollowed out into deep caves and lofty arches; and almost every promontory ends in a cluster of rocks, imitating the forms of columns, pinnacles, and obelisks.

The northernmost group of the British islands, the Shetland, is made up of a wide variety of rocks, including granite, gneiss, mica-slate, serpentine, greenstone, and many others, along with some secondary rocks, mainly sandstone and conglomerate. These islands are constantly exposed to the relentless force of the Atlantic, as there’s no land separating their western shores from America. As a result, strong westerly gales often drive the waves onto the coast with tremendous power, while there’s also a current coming from the north. The sea spray contributes to the breakdown of the rocks, making them more vulnerable to erosion from the waves. Steep cliffs are carved into deep caves and tall arches, and nearly every promontory ends in a cluster of rocks that resemble columns, pinnacles, and obelisks.

Drifting of large masses of rock.—Modern observations show that the reduction of continuous tracts to such insular masses is a process in which nature is still actively engaged. "The isle of Stenness," says Dr. Hibbert, "presents a scene of unequalled desolation. In stormy winters, huge blocks of stones are overturned, or are removed from their native beds, and hurried up a slight acclivity to a distance almost incredible. In the winter of 1802, a tabular-shaped mass, eight feet two inches by seven feet, and five feet one inch thick, was dislodged from its bed, and removed to a distance of from eighty to ninety feet. I measured the recent bed from which a block had been carried away the preceding winter (A. D. 1818), and found it to be seventeen feet and a half by seven feet, and the depth two feet eight inches. The removed mass had been borne to a distance of thirty feet, when it was shivered into thirteen or more lesser fragments, some of which, were carried still farther, from 30 to 120 feet. A block, nine feet two inches by six feet and a half, and four feet thick, was hurried up the acclivity to a distance of 150 feet."391

Drifting of large masses of rock.—Recent observations show that the process of turning continuous tracts into isolated masses is something nature is still actively doing. "The isle of Stenness," Dr. Hibbert notes, "presents a scene of unmatched desolation. During stormy winters, huge blocks of stone get overturned or moved from their original spots, and are rushed up a slight incline to distances that seem almost unbelievable. In the winter of 1802, a flat piece measuring eight feet two inches by seven feet and five feet one inch thick was dislodged from its place and moved about eighty to ninety feet away. I measured the spot from where a block had been taken the previous winter (A. D. 1818) and found it to be seventeen and a half feet by seven feet, with a depth of two feet eight inches. The removed mass had been carried thirty feet away before it shattered into thirteen or more smaller pieces, with some being moved even farther, between 30 to 120 feet. Another block, measuring nine feet two inches by six feet and a half, and four feet thick, was rushed up the incline to a distance of 150 feet."391

At Northmavine, also, angular blocks of stone have been removed in a similar manner to considerable distances by the waves of the sea, some of which are represented in the annexed figure.

At Northmavine, angular blocks of stone have also been moved over considerable distances by the waves of the sea, some of which are shown in the accompanying figure.

Effects of lightning.—In addition to numerous examples of masses detached and driven by the waves, tides, and currents from their place, some remarkable effects of lightning are recorded in these 299 isles. At Funzie, in Fetlar, about the middle of the last century, a rock of mica-schist, 105 feet long, ten feet broad, and in some places four feet thick, was in an instant torn by a flash of lightning from its bed, and broken into three large and several smaller fragments. One of these, twenty-six feet long, ten feet broad, and four feet thick, was simply turned over. The second, which was twenty-eight feet long, seventeen broad, and five feet in thickness, was hurled across a high point to the distance of fifty yards. Another broken mass, about forty feet long, was thrown still farther, but in the same direction, quite into the sea. There were also many smaller fragments scattered up and down.392

Effects of lightning.—Along with many examples of masses broken off and moved by waves, tides, and currents from their original locations, there are some notable effects of lightning recorded in these 299 islands. At Funzie, in Fetlar, around the middle of the last century, a rock made of mica-schist, 105 feet long, 10 feet wide, and up to 4 feet thick in some areas, was instantly ripped from its bed by a flash of lightning and shattered into three large pieces and several smaller ones. One of these pieces, measuring 26 feet long, 10 feet wide, and 4 feet thick, was simply flipped over. The second piece, which was 28 feet long, 17 feet wide, and 5 feet thick, was thrown across a high point a distance of 50 yards. Another broken piece, about 40 feet long, was thrown even farther, but in the same direction, right into the sea. Many smaller fragments were also scattered throughout the area.392

Fig. 27.

Fig. 27.

Stony fragments drifted by the sea.

Stony fragments drifted by the sea. Northmavine, Shetland.

Stony pieces floated by the sea. Northmavine, Shetland.

When we thus see electricity co-operating with the violent movements of the ocean in heaping up piles of shattered rocks on dry land and beneath the waters, we cannot but admit that a region which shall be the theatre, for myriads of ages, of the action of such disturbing causes, might present, at some future period, if upraised far above the bosom of the deep, a scene of havoc and ruin that may compare with any now found by the geologist on the surface of our continents.

When we see electricity working together with the powerful movements of the ocean to create mounds of broken rocks on land and underwater, we can't help but acknowledge that an area that has experienced such disruptive forces for countless ages might eventually, if lifted high above the sea, show a landscape of destruction and chaos that could rival anything currently observed by geologists on the surface of our continents.

In some of the Shetland Isles, as on the west of Meikle Roe, dikes, or veins of soft granite, have mouldered away; while the matrix in which they were inclosed, being of the same substance, but of a firmer texture, has remained unaltered. Thus, long narrow ravines, sometimes twenty feet wide, are laid open, and often give access to the waves. After describing some huge cavernous apertures into which the sea flows for 250 feet in Roeness, Dr. Hibbert, writing in 1822, enumerates other ravages of the ocean. "A mass of rock, the average dimensions of which may perhaps be rated at twelve or thirteen feet square, and four and a half or five in thickness, was first moved from its bed, about fifty years ago, to a distance of thirty feet, and has since been twice turned over."

In some of the Shetland Isles, like on the west side of Meikle Roe, dikes, or veins of soft granite, have crumbled away, while the surrounding rock, made of the same material but denser, has stayed unchanged. This has created long, narrow ravines, sometimes twenty feet wide, which often allow the waves to enter. After describing some massive openings that the sea flows into for 250 feet in Roeness, Dr. Hibbert, writing in 1822, points out other damages caused by the ocean. "A mass of rock, which might measure around twelve or thirteen feet square and four and a half or five feet thick, was moved from its original position about fifty years ago, to a distance of thirty feet, and has been flipped over twice since."

Passage forced by the sea through porphyritic rocks.—"But the most sublime scene is where a mural pile of porphyry, escaping the process 300 of disintegration that is devastating the coast, appears to have been left as a sort of rampart against the inroads of the ocean;—the Atlantic, when provoked by wintry gales, batters against it with all the force of real artillery—the waves having, in their repeated assaults, forced themselves an entrance. This breach, named the Grind of the Navir (fig. 28), is widened every winter by the overwhelming surge that, finding a passage through it, separates large stones from its sides, and forces them to a distance of no less than 180 feet. In two or three spots, the fragments which have been detached are brought together in immense heaps, that appear as an accumulation of cubical masses, the product of some quarry."393

Passage forced by the sea through porphyritic rocks.—"But the most stunning scene is where a massive stack of porphyry, resisting the erosion that's ravaging the coast, seems to stand as a sort of barrier against the ocean's advances;—the Atlantic, when stirred up by winter storms, crashes against it with all the power of real artillery—the waves, in their constant assaults, have forced their way in. This opening, called the Grind of the Navir (fig. 28), gets bigger every winter from the overwhelming waves that, finding a way through, pull large stones from its sides and push them as far as 180 feet away. In a few places, the fragments that have broken off gather into huge piles, resembling a collection of cube-shaped rocks, as if they came from some quarry."393

Fig. 28.Grind of the Navir.

Grind of the Navir—passage forced by the sea through rocks of hard porphyry.

Grind of the Navir—passage forced by the sea through hard porphyry rocks.

It is evident from this example, that although the greater indestructibility of some rocks may enable them to withstand, for a longer time, the action of the elements, yet they cannot permanently resist. There are localities in Shetland, in which rocks of almost every variety of mineral composition are suffering disintegration; thus the sea makes great inroads on the clay slate of Fitfel Head, on the serpentine of the Vord Hill in Fetlar, and on the mica-schist of the Bay of Triesta, on the east coast of the same island, which decomposes into angular blocks. The quartz rock on the east of Walls, and the gneiss and mica-schist of Garthness, suffer the same fate.

It's clear from this example that while some rocks can last longer against the elements due to their stronger durability, they still can’t resist permanently. In Shetland, there are places where rocks of nearly every mineral composition are breaking down. For instance, the sea is eroding the clay slate at Fitfel Head, the serpentine at Vord Hill in Fetlar, and the mica-schist at the Bay of Triesta on the east coast of the same island, which breaks apart into angular blocks. The quartz rock east of Walls, along with the gneiss and mica-schist at Garthness, faces the same deterioration.

Destruction of islands.—Such devastation cannot be incessantly committed for thousands of years without dividing islands, until they become at last mere clusters of rocks, the last shreds of masses once continuous. To this state many appear to have been reduced, and innumerable fantastic forms are assumed by rocks adjoining these islands to which the name of Drongs is applied, as it is to those of similar shape in Feroe.

Destruction of islands.—Such destruction can't go on forever for thousands of years without splitting islands apart, until they ultimately become just small groups of rocks, the last remnants of what were once connected landmasses. Many seem to have been brought to this condition, and countless strange shapes are taken on by the rocks near these islands, which are referred to as Drongs, just like those with similar forms in the Feroe Islands.

Fig. 29.

Granitic rocks named the Drongs, between Papa Stour and Hillswick Ness.

Granitic rocks called the Drongs, located between Papa Stour and Hillswick Ness.


Fig. 30.Granitic rocks to the south of Hillswick Ness, Shetland.

Granitic rocks to the south of Hillswick Ness, Shetland.

Granitic rocks south of Hillswick Ness, Shetland.

301 The granite rocks (fig. 29), between Papa Stour and Hillswick Ness afford an example. A still more singular cluster of rocks is seen to the south of Hillswick Ness (fig. 30), which presents a variety of forms as viewed from different points, and has often been likened to a small fleet of vessels with spread sails.394 We may imagine that in the course of time Hillswick Ness itself may present a similar wreck, from the unequal decomposition of the rocks whereof it is composed, consisting of gneiss and mica-schist traversed in all directions by veins of felspar-porphyry.

301 The granite rocks (fig. 29), between Papa Stour and Hillswick Ness, are a good example. An even more unusual cluster of rocks can be seen south of Hillswick Ness (fig. 30), which shows a variety of shapes from different angles and has often been compared to a small fleet of boats with their sails up.394 We can imagine that over time, Hillswick Ness itself may resemble a similar wreck due to the uneven breakdown of the rocks it's made of, which consist of gneiss and mica-schist crossed by veins of felspar-porphyry.

Midway between the groups of Shetland and Orkney is Fair Island, said to be composed of sandstone with high perpendicular cliffs. The current runs with such velocity, that during a calm, and when there is no swell, the rocks on its shores are white with the foam of the sea driven against them. The Orkneys, if carefully examined, would probably 302 illustrate our present topic as much as the Shetland group. The northeast promontory of Sanda, one of these islands, has been cut off in modern times by the sea, so that it became what is now called Start Island, where a lighthouse was erected in 1807, since which time the new strait has grown broader.

Midway between the Shetland and Orkney Islands is Fair Island, which is made up of sandstone and has steep vertical cliffs. The current runs so fast that during calm weather, when there are no waves, the rocks along the shore turn white with foam from the crashing sea. If you take a close look at the Orkneys, they would likely illustrate our current topic just as well as the Shetland Islands do. The northeast tip of Sanda, one of these islands, has been eroded by the sea in recent times, creating what is now known as Start Island, where a lighthouse was built in 1807, and since then, the new strait has widened.

East coast of Scotland.—To pass over to the main land of Scotland, we find that in Inverness-shire there have been inroads of the sea at Fort George, and others in Morayshire, which have swept away the old town of Findhorn. On the coast of Kincardineshire, an illustration was afforded at the close of the last century, of the effect of promontories in protecting a line of low shore. The village of Mathers, two miles south of Johnshaven, was built on an ancient shingle beach, protected by a projecting ledge of limestone rock. This was quarried for lime to such an extent that the sea broke through, and in 1795 carried away the whole village in one night, and penetrated 150 yards inland, where it has maintained its ground ever since, the new village having been built farther inland on the new shore. In the bay of Montrose, we find the North Esk and the South Esk rivers pouring annually into the sea large quantities of sand and pebbles; yet they have formed no deltas, for the waves, aided by the current, setting across their mouths, sweep away all the materials. Considerable beds of shingle, brought down by the North Esk, are seen along the beach.

East coast of Scotland.—To get to the mainland of Scotland, we discover that in Inverness-shire, the sea has encroached at Fort George, and in Morayshire, it has washed away the old town of Findhorn. Along the coast of Kincardineshire, there was a notable example at the end of the last century showing how promontories protect a stretch of low shoreline. The village of Mathers, situated two miles south of Johnshaven, was built on an ancient shingle beach, sheltered by a jutting ledge of limestone rock. This rock was quarried for lime to such an extent that the sea broke through, and in 1795, the entire village was swept away in one night, reaching 150 yards inland, where the sea has remained ever since. A new village has since been constructed further inland on the new shore. In the bay of Montrose, the North Esk and South Esk rivers deposit large amounts of sand and pebbles into the sea every year; however, they haven't formed deltas because the waves, along with the current flowing across their mouths, carry away all the sediment. Significant beds of shingle, washed down by the North Esk, can be seen along the beach.

Proceeding southwards, we learn that at Arbroath, in Forfarshire, which stands on a rock of red sandstone, gardens and houses have been carried away since the commencement of the present century by encroachments of the sea. It had become necessary before 1828, to remove the lighthouses at the mouth of the estuary of the Tay, in the same county, at Button Ness, which were built on a tract of blown sand, the sea having encroached for three-quarters of a mile.

Proceeding south, we learn that at Arbroath in Forfarshire, which is built on a red sandstone cliff, gardens and houses have been washed away since the start of this century due to the sea advancing. By 1828, it became necessary to relocate the lighthouses at the mouth of the Tay estuary in the same county at Button Ness, which were built on a sandy area that the sea had eroded by three-quarters of a mile.

Force of waves and currents in estuaries.—The combined power which waves and currents can exert in estuaries (a term which I confine to bays entered both by rivers and the tides of the sea), was remarkably exhibited during the building of the Bell Rock Lighthouse, off the mouth of the Tay. The Bell Rock is a sunken reef, consisting of red sandstone, being from twelve to sixteen feet under the surface at high water, and about twelve miles from the mainland. At the distance of 100 yards, there is a depth, in all directions of two or three fathoms at low water. In 1807, during the erection of the lighthouse, six large blocks of granite, which had been landed on the reef, were removed by the force of the sea, and thrown over a rising ledge to the distance of twelve or fifteen paces; and an anchor, weighing about 22 cwt., was thrown up upon the rock.395 Mr. Stevenson informs us moreover, that drift stones, measuring upwards of thirty cubic feet, or more than two tons' weight, have, during storms, been often thrown upon the rock from the deep water.396

Force of waves and currents in estuaries.—The combined power that waves and currents can have in estuaries (a term I use to refer to bays that are affected by both rivers and ocean tides) was clearly demonstrated during the construction of the Bell Rock Lighthouse, located at the mouth of the Tay. The Bell Rock is a submerged reef made of red sandstone, lying twelve to sixteen feet underwater at high tide and about twelve miles from the mainland. At a distance of 100 yards, the water is two to three fathoms deep in all directions at low tide. In 1807, while building the lighthouse, six large blocks of granite that had been placed on the reef were moved by the sea and thrown over a rising ledge, landing twelve to fifteen paces away. Additionally, an anchor weighing about 22 cwt. was lifted onto the rock.395 Mr. Stevenson also tells us that during storms, stones that measure over thirty cubic feet, or more than two tons, have often been washed onto the rock from deeper waters.396

303Submarine forests.—Among the proofs that the sea has encroached on the land bordering the estuary of the Tay, Dr. Fleming has mentioned a submarine forest which has been traced for several miles along the northern shore of the county of Fife.397 But subsequent surveys seem to have shown that the bed of peat containing tree-roots, leaves, and branches, now occurring at a lower level than the Tay, must have come into its present position by a general sinking of the ground on which the forest grew. The peat-bed alluded to is not confined, says Mr. Buist, to the present channel of the Tay, but extends far beyond it, and is covered by stratified clay from fifteen to twenty-five feet in thickness, in the midst of which, in some places, is a bed full of sea-shells.398 Recent discoveries having established the fact that upward and downward movements have affected our island since the general coast-line had nearly acquired its present shape, we must hesitate before we attribute any given change to a single cause, such as the local encroachment of the sea upon low land.

303Submarine forests.—Among the evidence that the sea has moved onto the land near the estuary of the Tay, Dr. Fleming has noted a submarine forest that can be traced for several miles along the northern shore of Fife.397 However, later surveys seem to indicate that the peat bed containing tree roots, leaves, and branches, which is currently found at a lower level than the Tay, must have settled there due to a general sinking of the ground on which the forest originally grew. Mr. Buist states that this peat bed isn't limited to the current channel of the Tay but extends much farther, covered by stratified clay that is fifteen to twenty-five feet thick, with some areas containing a layer rich in sea shells.398 Recent findings have confirmed that both upward and downward movements have impacted our island since the coastline took on its current shape, so we should be cautious about attributing any specific change to a single cause, like the local encroachment of the sea on low-lying land.

On the coast of Fife, at St. Andrew's, a tract of land, said to have intervened between the castle of Cardinal Beaton and the sea, has been entirely swept away, as were the last remains of the Priory of Crail, in the same county, in 1803. On both sides of the Frith of Forth, land has been consumed; at North Berwick in particular, and at Newhaven, where an arsenal and dock, built in the reign of James IV., in the fifteenth century, has been overflowed.

On the coast of Fife, at St. Andrews, a piece of land that used to exist between Cardinal Beaton's castle and the sea has completely vanished, just like the last remnants of the Priory of Crail, which disappeared in 1803. Land has been lost on both sides of the Firth of Forth; notably at North Berwick and Newhaven, where an arsenal and dock built during the reign of James IV in the 15th century have been submerged.

East coast of England.—If we now proceed to the English coast, we find records of numerous lands having been destroyed in Northumberland, as those near Bamborough and Holy Island, and at Tynemouth Castle, which now overhangs the sea, although formerly separated from it by a strip of land. At Hartlepool, and several other parts of the coast of Durham composed of magnesian limestone, the sea has made considerable inroads.

East coast of England.—If we now head to the English coast, we find records of many areas that have been eroded in Northumberland, such as those near Bamburgh and Holy Island, and at Tynemouth Castle, which now overlooks the sea, although it used to be separated from it by a stretch of land. At Hartlepool and several other spots along the coast of Durham made up of magnesian limestone, the sea has made significant progress in eroding the land.

Coast of Yorkshire.—Almost the whole coast of Yorkshire, from the mouth of the Tees to that of the Humber, is in a state of gradual dilapidation. That part of the cliffs which consist of lias, the oolite series, and chalk, decays slowly. They present abrupt and naked precipices, often 300 feet in height; and it is only at a few points that the grassy covering of the sloping talus marks a temporary relaxation of the erosive action of the sea. The chalk cliffs are worn into caves and needles in the projecting headland of Flamborough, where they are decomposed by the salt spray, and slowly crumble away. But the waste is most rapid between that promontory and Spurn Point, or the coast of Holderness, as it is called, a tract consisting of beds of clay, gravel, sand, and chalk rubble. The irregular intermixture of the argillaceous beds causes many springs to be thrown out, and this facilitates the undermining process, the waves beating against them, and a strong current 304 setting chiefly from the north. The wasteful action is very conspicuous at Dimlington Height, the loftiest point in Holderness, where the beacon stands on a cliff 146 feet above high water, the whole being composed of clay, with pebbles scattered through it.399 "For many years," says Professor Phillips, "the rate at which the cliffs recede from Bridlington to Spurn, a distance of thirty-six miles, has been found by measurement to equal on an average two and a quarter yards annually, which, upon thirty-six miles of coast, would amount to about thirty acres a year. At this rate, the coast, the mean height of which above the sea is about forty feet, has lost one mile in breadth since the Norman Conquest, and more than two miles since the occupation of York (Eboracum) by the Romans."400 The extent of this denudation, as estimated by the number of cubic feet of matter removed annually, will be again spoken of in chapter 22.

Coast of Yorkshire.—Almost the entire coast of Yorkshire, from the mouth of the Tees to that of the Humber, is gradually falling apart. The sections of the cliffs made up of lias, the oolite series, and chalk erode slowly. They feature steep and bare cliffs, often reaching 300 feet in height, and only at a few locations does the grassy cover of the sloping base indicate a temporary slowdown in the erosion caused by the sea. The chalk cliffs have worn into caves and spires at the prominent headland of Flamborough, where they are broken down by salt spray and slowly disintegrate. However, the erosion is most rapid between that headland and Spurn Point, known as the coast of Holderness, which consists of layers of clay, gravel, sand, and chalk debris. The uneven mix of the clay layers causes many springs to emerge, which helps with the undermining process as waves crash against them, and a strong current mainly flows from the north. The erosion is particularly notable at Dimlington Height, the highest point in Holderness, where a beacon stands on a cliff 146 feet above high tide, all made of clay with pebbles scattered throughout it.399 "For many years," says Professor Phillips, "the rate at which the cliffs recede from Bridlington to Spurn, a distance of thirty-six miles, has been measured to average two and a quarter yards per year, which, over thirty-six miles of coastline, amounts to about thirty acres a year. At this rate, the coast, which has an average height of about forty feet above sea level, has lost one mile in width since the Norman Conquest and more than two miles since the Romans occupied York (Eboracum)."400 The extent of this erosion, as estimated by the cubic feet of material removed annually, will be discussed again in chapter 22.

In the old maps of Yorkshire, we find spots, now sand-banks in the sea, marked as the ancient sites of the towns and villages of Auburn, Hartburn, and Hyde. "Of Hyde," says Pennant, "only the tradition is left; and near the village of Hornsea, a street called Hornsea Beck has long since been swallowed."401 Owthorne and its church have also been in great part destroyed, and the village of Kilnsea; but these places are now removed farther inland. The annual rate of encroachment at Owthorne for several years preceding 1830, is stated to have averaged about four yards. Not unreasonable fears are entertained that at some future time the Spurn Point will become an island, and that the ocean, entering into the estuary of the Humber, will cause great devastation.402 Pennant, after speaking of the silting up of some ancient ports in that estuary, observes, "But, in return, the sea has made most ample reprisals; the site, and even the very names of several places, once towns of note upon the Humber, are now only recorded in history; and Ravensper was at one time a rival to Hull (Madox, Ant. Exch. i. 422), and a port so very considerable in 1332, that Edward Baliol and the confederated English barons sailed from hence to invade Scotland; and Henry IV., in 1399, made choice of this port to land at, to effect the deposal of Richard II.; yet the whole of this has long since been devoured by the merciless ocean; extensive sands, dry at low water, are to be seen in their stead."403

In the old maps of Yorkshire, we find spots, now sandbanks in the sea, marked as the ancient locations of the towns and villages of Auburn, Hartburn, and Hyde. "Of Hyde," says Pennant, "only the tradition remains; and near the village of Hornsea, a street called Hornsea Beck has long been swallowed." Owthorne and its church have also been largely destroyed, along with the village of Kilnsea; but these places have now moved farther inland. The annual rate of encroachment at Owthorne for several years before 1830 is reported to have averaged about four yards. There are reasonable fears that at some point in the future, Spurn Point will become an island, and that the ocean, flowing into the estuary of the Humber, will cause significant destruction. Pennant, after discussing the silting up of some ancient ports in that estuary, notes, "But, in return, the sea has taken ample revenge; the locations, and even the very names of several places, once notable towns on the Humber, are now recorded only in history; and Ravensper was once a competitor to Hull (Madox, Ant. Exch. i. 422), and a port so significant in 1332 that Edward Baliol and the allied English barons sailed from here to invade Scotland; and Henry IV., in 1399, chose this port to land at to depose Richard II.; yet all of this has long since been consumed by the relentless ocean; vast sands, dry at low tide, are now seen in their place."

Pennant describes Spurn Head as a promontory in the form of a sickle, and says the land, for some miles to the north, was "perpetually preyed on by the fury of the German Sea, which devours whole acres at a time, and exposes on the shores considerable quantities of beautiful amber."

Pennant describes Spurn Head as a sickle-shaped promontory and notes that the land, several miles to the north, is "constantly attacked by the rage of the North Sea, which consumes whole acres at a time and reveals large amounts of beautiful amber on the shores."

Lincolnshire.—The maritime district of Lincolnshire consists chiefly of lands that lie below the level of the sea, being protected by embankments. 305 Some of the fens were embanked and drained by the Romans; but after their departure the sea returned, and large tracts were covered with beds of silt, containing marine shells, now again converted into productive lands. Many dreadful catastrophes are recorded by incursions of the sea, whereby several parishes have been at different times overwhelmed.

Lincolnshire.—The coastal area of Lincolnshire mainly consists of land that is below sea level, protected by levees. 305 Some of the marshlands were leveed and drained by the Romans; however, after they left, the sea returned, covering large areas with layers of silt filled with marine shells, which have now been transformed back into fertile land. There are many terrible disasters recorded due to the sea invading, resulting in several parishes being submerged at different times.

Norfolk.—The decay of the cliffs of Norfolk and Suffolk is incessant. At Hunstanton, on the north, the undermining of the lower arenaceous beds at the foot of the cliff, causes masses of red and white chalk to be precipitated from above. Between Hunstanton and Weybourne, low hills, or dunes, of blown sand, are formed along the shore, from fifty to sixty feet high. They are composed of dry sand, bound in a compact mass by the long creeping roots of the plant called Marram (Arundo arenaria). Such is the present set of the tides, that the harbors of Clay, Wells, and other places are securely defended by these barriers; affording a clear proof that it is not the strength of the material at particular points that determines whether the sea shall be progressive or stationary, but the general contour of the coast.

Norfolk.—The cliffs of Norfolk and Suffolk are constantly eroding. At Hunstanton in the north, the lower sandy layers at the base of the cliff are being worn away, causing large chunks of red and white chalk to fall from above. Between Hunstanton and Weybourne, low hills, or dunes, of blown sand rise along the shore, reaching heights of fifty to sixty feet. These are made of dry sand held together in a solid form by the long, creeping roots of a plant called Marram (Arundo arenaria). Because of the current tides, the harbors of Clay, Wells, and other areas are well protected by these natural barriers. This clearly shows that it’s not just the strength of the material at specific points that decides whether the sea will advance or stay put, but rather the overall shape of the coastline.

The waves constantly undermine the low chalk cliffs, covered with sand and clay, between Weybourne and Sherringham, a certain portion of them being annually removed. At the latter town I ascertained, in 1829, some facts which throw light on the rate at which the sea gains upon the land. It was computed, when the present inn was built, in 1805, that it would require seventy years for the sea to reach the spot: the mean loss of land being calculated, from previous observations, to be somewhat less than one yard, annually. The distance between the house and the sea was fifty yards; but no allowance was made for the slope of the ground being from the sea, in consequence of which the waste was naturally accelerated every year, as the cliff grew lower, there being at each succeeding period less matter to remove when portions of equal area fell down. Between the years 1824 and 1829, no less than seventeen yards were swept away, and only a small garden was then left between the building and the sea. There was, in 1829, a depth of twenty feet (sufficient to float a frigate) at one point in the harbor of that port, where, only forty-eight years before, there stood a cliff fifty feet high, with houses upon it! If once in half a century an equal amount of change were produced suddenly by the momentary shock of an earthquake, history would be filled with records of such wonderful revolutions of the earth's surface; but, if the conversion of high land into deep sea be gradual, it excites only local attention. The flagstaff of the Preventive Service station, on the south side of this harbor, was thrice removed inland between the years 1814 and 1829, in consequence of the advance of the sea.

The waves continuously erode the low chalk cliffs, covered in sand and clay, between Weybourne and Sherringham, with a certain amount being washed away every year. In 1829, I discovered some facts in the latter town that shed light on how quickly the sea is encroaching on the land. When the current inn was built in 1805, it was estimated that it would take seventy years for the sea to reach that point, with the average loss of land calculated from earlier observations to be just under one yard per year. The distance between the house and the sea was fifty yards; however, no consideration was given to the slope of the ground away from the sea, which naturally accelerated erosion each year as the cliff got lower, leaving less material to erode with each section that collapsed. Between 1824 and 1829, a total of seventeen yards were washed away, leaving just a small garden between the building and the sea. In 1829, there was a depth of twenty feet (enough to float a frigate) at one point in the harbor, where only forty-eight years earlier, there had been a cliff standing fifty feet high, complete with houses! If such a significant change occurred suddenly due to an earthquake once every fifty years, history would be filled with accounts of these remarkable changes in the earth's surface; however, when the transformation of high land into deep sea happens gradually, it only catches local attention. The flagpole of the Preventive Service station on the south side of the harbor was moved inland three times between 1814 and 1829 due to the advancing sea.

Farther to the south we find cliffs, composed, like those of Holderness before mentioned, of alternating strata of blue clay, gravel, loam, and fine sand. Although they sometimes exceed 300 feet in height, the havoc made on the coast is most formidable. The whole site of ancient 306 Cromer now forms part of the German Ocean, the inhabitants having gradually retreated inland to their present situation, from whence the sea still threatens to dislodge them. In the winter of 1825, a fallen mass was precipitated from near the lighthouse, which covered twelve acres, extending far into the sea, the cliffs being 250 feet in height.404 The undermining by springs has sometimes caused large portions of the upper part of the cliffs, with houses still standing upon them, to give way, so that it is impossible, by erecting breakwaters at the base of the cliffs, permanently to ward off the danger.

Further south, we find cliffs made up, like those in Holderness mentioned earlier, of layers of blue clay, gravel, loam, and fine sand. Although they sometimes rise over 300 feet, the destruction along the coast is quite severe. The entire area where ancient Cromer used to be is now part of the German Ocean, as the residents have slowly moved inland to their current location, from where the sea still threatens to push them out. In the winter of 1825, a large section fell off near the lighthouse, covering twelve acres and extending far into the sea, with the cliffs being 250 feet high.404 The erosion caused by springs has sometimes led to large sections of the upper part of the cliffs, with houses still on them, collapsing, making it impossible to fully protect against the danger by building breakwaters at the base of the cliffs.

Fig. 31.Tower of the buried Church of Eccles, Norfolk.

Tower of the buried Church of Eccles, Norfolk, A. D. 1839.
The inland slope of the hills of blown sand is shown in this view, with the lighthouse of Hasborough in the distance.

Tower of the buried Church of Eccles, Norfolk, A.D. 1839.
This view shows the inland slope of the sand hills, with the Hasborough lighthouse in the distance.

On the same coast, says Mr. R. C. Taylor, the ancient villages of Shipden, Wimpwell, and Eccles have disappeared; several manors and large portions of neighboring parishes having, piece after piece, been swallowed up; nor has there been any intermission, from time immemorial, in the ravages of the sea along a line of coast twenty miles in length, in which these places stood.405 Of Eccles, however, a monument still remains in the rained tower of the old church, which is half buried in the dunes of sand within a few paces (60?) of the sea-beach (fig. 31). So early as 1605 the inhabitants petitioned James I. for a reduction of taxes, as 300 acres of land, and all their houses, save fourteen, had then been destroyed by the sea. Not one half that number of acres now remains in the parish, and hills of blown sand now occupy the site of the houses which were still extant in 1605. When I visited the spot in 1839, the sea was fast encroaching on the sand-hills, and had laid open on the beach the foundations of a house fourteen yards square, the upper part of which had evidently been pulled down before it had been buried under sand. The body of the church has also been long buried, but the tower still remains visible.

On the same coast, Mr. R. C. Taylor notes that the ancient villages of Shipden, Wimpwell, and Eccles have vanished; several manors and large parts of nearby parishes have been gradually washed away. There hasn’t been any break, for as long as anyone can remember, in the destruction caused by the sea along a coastline that stretches twenty miles, where these places once stood.405 However, a remnant of Eccles remains in the ruined tower of the old church, which is half-buried in the sand dunes just a short distance (about 60 yards) from the beach (fig. 31). As early as 1605, the residents requested King James I for a tax reduction since 300 acres of land and all their houses except for fourteen had already been lost to the sea. Now, less than half that amount of land is left in the parish, and mounds of sand have taken over the location of the houses that were still standing in 1605. When I visited the area in 1839, the sea was rapidly eroding the sand hills and had exposed the foundations of a house measuring fourteen yards square on the beach, with the top part clearly demolished before being buried under sand. The main body of the church has long been buried, but the tower is still visible.

307 M. E. de Beaumont has suggested that sand-dunes in Holland and other countries may serve as natural chronometers, by which the date of the existing continents may be ascertained. The sands, he says, are continually blown inland by the force of the winds, and by observing the rate of their march we may calculate the period when the movement commenced.406 But the example just given will satisfy every geologist that we cannot ascertain the starting-point of dunes, all coasts being liable to waste, and the shores of the Low Countries in particular, being not only exposed to inroads of the sea, but, as M. de Beaumont himself has well shown, having even in historical times undergone a change of level. The dunes may indeed, in some cases, be made use of as chronometers, to enable us to assign a minimum of antiquity to existing coast-lines; but this test must be applied with great caution, so variable is the rate at which the sands may advance into the interior.

307 M. E. de Beaumont has suggested that sand dunes in Holland and other countries could act as natural clocks to determine when the current continents formed. He points out that the winds constantly blow the sands inland, and by tracking their movement, we can estimate when this process started.406 However, the example provided makes it clear to any geologist that we cannot pinpoint the starting time of dunes, as all coastlines are prone to erosion, and especially the shores of the Low Countries have, as M. de Beaumont himself has demonstrated, undergone changes in elevation even in historical times. While dunes can sometimes be used as rough markers to establish a minimum age for existing coastlines, this method must be applied very carefully, as the rate at which the sands move inland can vary greatly.

Hills of blown sand, between Eccles and Winterton, have barred up and excluded the tide for many hundred years from the mouths of several small estuaries; but there are records of nine breaches, from 20 to 120 yards wide, having been made through these, by which immense damage was done to the low grounds in the interior. A few miles south of Happisburgh, also, are hills of blown sand, which extend to Yarmouth. These dunes afford a temporary protection to the coast, and an inland cliff, about a mile long, at Winterton, shows clearly that at that point the sea must have penetrated formerly farther than at present.

Hills of blown sand between Eccles and Winterton have blocked the tide from entering several small estuaries for hundreds of years. However, there are records of nine breaches, ranging from 20 to 120 yards wide, that have caused significant damage to the low-lying areas inland. A few miles south of Happisburgh, there are also hills of blown sand that stretch toward Yarmouth. These dunes provide temporary protection to the coast, and an inland cliff about a mile long at Winterton clearly shows that the sea must have once extended farther inland than it does now.

Silting up of estuaries/—At Yarmouth, the sea has not advanced upon the sands in the slightest degree since the reign of Elizabeth. In the time of the Saxons, a great estuary extended as far as Norwich, which city, is represented; even in the thirteenth and fourteenth centuries, as "situated on the banks of an arm of the sea." The sands whereon Yarmouth is built, first became firm and habitable ground about the year 1008, from which time a line of dunes has gradually increased in height and breadth, stretching across the whole entrance of the ancient estuary, and obstructing the ingress of the tides so completely, that they are only admitted by the narrow passage which the river keeps open, and which has gradually shifted several miles to the south. The ordinary tides at the river's mouth rise, at present, only to the height, of three or four feet, the spring tides to about eight or nine.

Silting up of estuaries/—At Yarmouth, the sea hasn’t moved onto the sands at all since the reign of Elizabeth. During the Saxon era, a large estuary extended all the way to Norwich, which is described even in the thirteenth and fourteenth centuries as "located on the banks of an arm of the sea." The sands where Yarmouth is built became solid and livable ground around the year 1008, and since then, a line of dunes has gradually grown taller and wider, stretching across the entire entrance of the old estuary. This has blocked the incoming tides so completely that they can now only enter through the narrow passage that the river maintains, which has slowly shifted several miles to the south. Currently, the usual tides at the river's mouth only rise to about three or four feet, while the spring tides reach around eight or nine.

By the exclusion of the sea, thousands of acres in the interior have become cultivated lands; and, exclusive of smaller pools, upwards of sixty freshwater lakes have been formed, varying in depth from fifteen to thirty feet, and in extent from one acre to twelve hundred.407 The Yare, and other rivers, frequently communicate with these sheets of water; and thus they are liable to be filled up gradually with lacustrine and fluviatile deposits, and to be converted into land covered with 308 forests. Yet it must not be imagined, that the acquisition of new land fit for cultivation in Norfolk and Suffolk indicates any permanent growth of the eastern limits of our island to compensate its reiterated losses. No delta can form on such a shore.

By blocking off the sea, thousands of acres inland have turned into farmland; aside from smaller ponds, over sixty freshwater lakes have formed, ranging in depth from fifteen to thirty feet and in size from one acre to twelve hundred. 407 The Yare and other rivers often connect with these bodies of water, which makes them vulnerable to gradually filling up with sediment from lakes and rivers, eventually becoming land covered in forests. However, it's important not to think that gaining new land suitable for farming in Norfolk and Suffolk means there’s any permanent expansion of the eastern edge of our island to make up for its repeated losses. No delta can form on such a shore.

Immediately off Yarmouth, and parallel to the shore, is a great range of sand-banks, the shape of which varies slowly from year to year, and often suddenly after great storms. Captain Hewitt, R. N., found in these banks, in 1836, a broad channel sixty-five feet deep, where there was only a depth of four feet during a prior survey in 1822. The sea had excavated to the depth of sixty feet in the course of fourteen years, or perhaps a shorter period. The new channel thus formed serves at present (1838), for the entrance of ships into Yarmouth Roads; and the magnitude of this change shows how easily a new set of the waves and currents might endanger the submergence of the land gained within the ancient estuary of the Yare.

Right off Yarmouth and alongside the shore, there’s a large stretch of sandbars that change shape slowly from year to year and often shift suddenly after major storms. Captain Hewitt, R. N., discovered a wide channel sixty-five feet deep in these banks in 1836, where a previous survey in 1822 showed only four feet of depth. The sea had dug down to sixty feet over fourteen years, or possibly even less time. The new channel that formed now serves (in 1838) as the entrance for ships into Yarmouth Roads, and the extent of this change demonstrates how easily a new pattern of waves and currents could threaten the land reclaimed within the old estuary of the Yare.

That great banks should be thrown across the mouths of estuaries on our eastern coast, where there is not a large body of river-water to maintain an open channel, is perfectly intelligible, when we bear in mind that the marine current, sweeping along the coast, is charged with the materials of wasting cliffs, and ready to form a bar anywhere the instant its course is interrupted or checked by any opposing stream. The mouth of the Yare has been, within the last five centuries, diverted about four miles to the south. In like manner it is evident that, at some remote period, the river Alde entered the sea at Aldborough, until its ancient outlet was barred up and at length transferred to a point no less than ten miles distant to the southwest. In this case, ridges of sand and shingle, like those of Lowestoff Ness, which will be described by and by, have been thrown up between the river and the sea; and an ancient sea-cliff is to be seen now inland.

That large banks should be built across the mouths of estuaries on our eastern coast, where there isn't a big body of river water to keep an open channel, makes perfect sense when we consider that the ocean current, flowing along the coast, is loaded with materials from eroding cliffs, and is ready to create a sandbar anywhere its path is disturbed by any opposing stream. The mouth of the Yare has been redirected about four miles to the south over the last five centuries. Similarly, it's clear that, at some distant time, the river Alde flowed into the sea at Aldborough until its old outlet was blocked and eventually moved to a point at least ten miles southwest. In this case, ridges of sand and pebbles, like those at Lowestoff Ness, which will be described later, have built up between the river and the sea; and an ancient sea cliff can now be seen inland.

It may be asked why the rivers on our east coast are always deflected southwards, although the tidal current flows alternately from the south and north? The cause is to be found in the superior force of what is commonly called "the flood tide from the north," a tidal wave derived from the Atlantic, a small part of which passes eastward up the English Channel, and through the Straits of Dover and then northwards, while the principal body of water, moving much more rapidly in a more open sea, on the western side of Britain, first passes the Orkneys, and then turning, flows down between Norway and Scotland, and sweeps with great velocity along our eastern coast. It is well known that the highest tides on this coast are occasioned by a powerful northwest wind, which raises the eastern part of the Atlantic, and causes it to pour a greater volume of water into the German Ocean. This circumstance of a violent off-shore wind being attended with a rise of the waters, instead of a general retreat of the sea, naturally excites the wonder of the inhabitants of our coast. In many districts they look with confidence for a rich harvest of that valuable manure, the sea-weed, when the north-westerly gales prevail, and are rarely disappointed.

It might be asked why the rivers on our east coast are always pushed southward, even though the tidal current alternates from the south and north. The reason lies in the stronger force of what’s commonly called "the flood tide from the north," a tidal wave that comes from the Atlantic. A small part of this wave moves eastward up the English Channel and through the Straits of Dover, then heads north. Meanwhile, the main body of water, moving much more quickly in the open sea on the western side of Britain, first passes the Orkney Islands and then curls down between Norway and Scotland, rushing along our eastern coast. It’s well known that the highest tides on this coast are caused by a strong northwest wind, which raises the eastern part of the Atlantic and pushes more water into the North Sea. This situation, where a strong offshore wind results in a rise of the waters instead of a general retreat of the sea, understandably amazes the people living along our coast. In many areas, they期待 a bountiful harvest of the valuable seaweed when the northwesterly gales occur, and they are rarely let down.

Fig. 32.

Fig. 32.

Map of Lowestoff Ness, Suffolk.

Map of Lowestoff Ness, Suffolk.408

Map of Lowestoft Ness, Suffolk.408

a, a. The dotted lines express a series of sand and shingle, forming the extremity of the triangular space called the Ness.

a, a. The dotted lines show a stretch of sand and gravel, marking the edge of the triangular area known as the Ness.

b, b, b. The dark line represents the inland cliff on which the town of Lowestoff stands, between which and the sea is the Ness.

b, b, b. The dark line shows the inland cliff where the town of Lowestoff is located, with the Ness lying between it and the sea.

309Coast of Suffolk.—The cliffs of Suffolk, to which we next proceed, are somewhat less elevated than those of Norfolk, but composed of similar alternations of clay, sand, and gravel. From Gorleston in Suffolk, to within a few miles north of Lowestoff, the cliffs are slowly undermined. Near the last-mentioned town, there is an inland cliff about sixty feet high, the sloping talus of which is covered with turf and heath. Between the cliff and the sea is a low flat tract of sand called the Ness, nearly three miles long, and for the most part out of reach of the highest tides. The point of the Ness projects from the base of the original cliff to the distance of 660 yards. This accession of land, says Mr. Taylor, has been effected at distinct and distant intervals, by the influence of currents running between the land and a shoal about a mile off Lowestoff, called the Holm Sand. The lines of growth in the Ness are indicated by a series of concentric ridges or embankments inclosing limited areas, and several of these ridges have been formed within the observation of persons now living. A rampart of heavy materials is first thrown up to an unusual altitude by some extraordinary tide, attended with a violent gale. Subsequent tides extend the base of this high bank of shingle, and the interstices are then filled with sand blown from the beach. The Arundo and other marine plants by degrees obtain a footing; and creeping along the ridge, give solidity to the mass, and form in some cases a matted covering of turf. Meanwhile another mound is forming externally, which by the like process rises and gives protection to the first. If the sea forces its way through one of the external and incomplete mounds, the breach is soon repaired. After a while the marine plants within the areas inclosed by these embankments are succeeded by a better species of herbage affording good pasturage, and the sands become sufficiently firm to support buildings.

309Coast of Suffolk.—The cliffs of Suffolk, which we will discuss next, are a bit shorter than those in Norfolk, but made up of similar layers of clay, sand, and gravel. From Gorleston in Suffolk up to a few miles north of Lowestoft, the cliffs are gradually being eroded. Near Lowestoft, there's an inland cliff about sixty feet high, with a sloping area covered in grass and heath. Between the cliff and the sea lies a low, flat stretch of sand known as the Ness, nearly three miles long, mostly above the reach of the highest tides. The end of the Ness extends from the base of the original cliff out to about 660 yards. Mr. Taylor notes that this addition of land has occurred at distinct and separate times due to currents flowing between the land and a sandbar about a mile off Lowestoft, called the Holm Sand. The growth lines in the Ness are marked by a series of concentric ridges or embankments that enclose small areas, and some of these ridges have formed within the lifetimes of people living today. A barrier of heavy materials is first built up to an unusual height by an extraordinary tide accompanied by a strong gale. Subsequent tides expand the base of this high bank of shingle, and the gaps are then filled with sand blown from the beach. The Arundo and other coastal plants gradually take root; as they spread along the ridge, they help stabilize the mass and sometimes create a thick mat of grass. Meanwhile, another mound forms on the outside, which through a similar process rises to protect the first mound. If the sea breaks through one of the outer, unfinished mounds, the breach is quickly repaired. Eventually, the marine plants within the areas enclosed by these embankments are replaced by better-quality grasses that provide good grazing, and the sands become solid enough to support buildings.

Destruction of Dunwich by the sea.—Of the gradual destruction of Dunwich, once the most considerable seaport on this coast, we have many authentic records. Gardner, in his history of that borough, 310 published in 1754, shows, by reference to documents, beginning with Doomsday Book, that the cliffs at Dunwich, Southwold, Eastern, and Pakefield, have been always subject to wear away. At Dunwich, in particular, two tracts of land which had been taxed in the eleventh century, in the time of King Edward the Confessor, are mentioned in the Conqueror's survey, made but a few years afterwards, as having been devoured by the sea. The losses, at a subsequent period, of a monastery,—at another of several churches,—afterwards of the old port,—then of four hundred houses at once,—of the church of St. Leonard, the high-road, town-hall, jail, and many other buildings, are mentioned, with the dates when they perished. It is stated that, in the sixteenth century, not one-quarter of the town was left standing; yet the inhabitants retreating inland, the name was preserved, as has been the case with many other ports when their ancient site has been blotted out. There is, however, a church of considerable antiquity still standing, the last of twelve mentioned in some records. In 1740, the laying open of the churchyard of St. Nicholas and St. Francis, in the sea-cliffs, is well described by Gardner, with the coffins and skeletons exposed to view—some lying on the beach, and rocked

Destruction of Dunwich by the sea.—We have numerous reliable records about the gradual destruction of Dunwich, which was once the most important seaport on this coast. Gardner, in his history of that borough, 310 published in 1754, shows, using references from documents starting with the Domesday Book, that the cliffs at Dunwich, Southwold, Eastern, and Pakefield have always been eroding. Specifically at Dunwich, two areas of land that were taxed in the eleventh century, during King Edward the Confessor's reign, are noted in the Conqueror's survey made just a few years later as having been consumed by the sea. The losses, at a later time, include a monastery, followed by several churches, then the old port, then four hundred houses all at once, the church of St. Leonard, the main road, town hall, jail, and many other buildings, all documented with the dates of their disappearance. It is noted that by the sixteenth century, not even a quarter of the town remained; nevertheless, the residents moved inland, allowing the name to endure, as has happened with many other ports when their original locations have been washed away. However, there is still an ancient church standing, the last of twelve mentioned in some records. In 1740, Gardner offers a vivid description of the exposure of the churchyard of St. Nicholas and St. Francis in the sea-cliffs, revealing coffins and skeletons—some lying on the beach, and rocked

"In cradle of the rude imperious surge."

"In the cradle of the rough, commanding wave."

Of these cemeteries no remains can now be seen. Ray also says, "that ancient writings make mention of a wood a mile and a half to the east of Dunwich, the site of which must at present be so far within the sea."409 This city, once so flourishing and populous, is now a small village, with about twenty houses, and one hundred inhabitants.

Of these cemeteries, there are no remains visible today. Ray also mentions that "ancient writings refer to a forest a mile and a half to the east of Dunwich, the location of which must now be well beneath the sea."409 This city, once thriving and filled with people, is now just a small village with about twenty houses and a hundred residents.

There is an old tradition, "that the tailors sat in their shops at Dunwich, and saw the ships in Yarmouth Bay;" but when we consider how far the coast at Lowestoff Ness projects between these places, we cannot give credit to the tale, which, nevertheless, proves how much the inroads of the sea in times of old had prompted men of lively imagination to indulge their taste for the marvellous.

There’s an old saying that "the tailors sat in their shops in Dunwich and watched the ships in Yarmouth Bay;" but when we think about how far the coast at Lowestoff Ness sticks out between these two places, we can't believe the story. Still, it shows how much the encroachment of the sea in ancient times inspired imaginative people to enjoy tales of the extraordinary.

Gardner's description of the cemeteries laid open by the waves reminds us of the scene which has been so well depicted by Bewick,410 and of which numerous points on the same coast might have suggested the idea. On the verge of a cliff, which the sea has undermined, are represented the unshaken tower and western end of an abbey. The eastern aisle is gone, and the pillars of the cloister are soon to follow. The waves have almost isolated the promontory, and invaded the cemetery, where they have made sport with the mortal relics, and thrown up a skull upon the beach. In the foreground is seen a broken tombstone, erected, as its legend tells, "to perpetuate the memory"—of one whose name is obliterated, as is that of the county for which he was "Custos Rotulorum." A cormorant is perched on the monument, 311 defiling it, as if to remind some moralizer like Hamlet, of "the base uses" to which things sacred may be turned. Had this excellent artist desired to satirize certain popular theories of geology, he might have inscribed the stone to the memory of some philosopher who taught "the permanency of existing continents"—"the era of repose"—"the impotence of modern causes."

Gardner's description of the cemeteries exposed by the waves reminds us of the scene that Bewick captured so well,410 and that numerous spots along the same coast could have inspired. On the edge of a cliff, which the sea has eroded, we see the steadfast tower and western end of an abbey. The eastern aisle is gone, and the pillars of the cloister are soon to fall. The waves have almost separated the promontory and invaded the cemetery, where they have played with the remains and washed a skull up onto the beach. In the foreground, there’s a broken tombstone, erected, as its inscription states, "to perpetuate the memory"—of someone whose name has faded, as has that of the county for which he served as "Custos Rotulorum." A cormorant sits atop the monument, marring it, as if to remind a moralist like Hamlet of "the base uses" to which sacred things can be put. If this talented artist wanted to mock certain popular geological theories, he might have inscribed the stone in memory of some philosopher who taught about "the permanency of existing continents"—"the era of repose"—"the impotence of modern causes."

The incursions of the sea at Aldborough, were formerly very destructive, and this borough is known to have been once situated a quarter of a mile east of the present shore. The inhabitants continued to build farther inland, till they arrived at the extremity of their property, and then the town decayed greatly; but two sand-banks, thrown up at a short distance, now afford a temporary safeguard to the coast. Between these banks and the present shore, where the current now flows, the sea is twenty-four feet deep on the spot where the town formerly stood.

The sea encroachments at Aldborough were once very damaging, and this borough is known to have been located a quarter of a mile east of the current shoreline. The residents kept building further inland until they reached the edge of their land, and then the town declined significantly; however, two sandbanks created nearby now provide a temporary barrier to the coast. Between these banks and the current shoreline, where the current flows, the sea is twenty-four feet deep at the location where the town used to be.

Essex.—Harwich is said to have owed its rise to the destruction of Orwell, a town which stood on the spot now called "the west rocks," and was overwhelmed by an inroad of the sea since the Conquest. Apprehensions have been entertained that the isthmus on which Harwich stands may at no remote period become an island, for the sea may be expected to make a breach near Lower Dover Court, where Beacon Cliff is composed of horizontal beds of London clay containing septaria. It had wasted away considerably between the years 1829 and 1838, at both which periods I examined this coast. In that short interval several gardens and many houses had been swept into the sea, and in April, 1838, a whole street was threatened with destruction. The advance of the sea is much accelerated by the traffic carried on in septaria, which are shipped off for cement as fast as they fall down upon the beach. These stones, if allowed to remain in heaps on the shore, would break the force of the waves and retard the conversion of the peninsula into an island, an event which might be followed by the destruction of the town of Harwich. Captain Washington, R. N., ascertained in 1847, that Beacon Cliff, above mentioned, which is about fifty feet high, had given way at the rate of forty feet in forty-seven years, between 1709 and 1756; eighty feet between 1756 and 1804; and three hundred and fifty feet between the latter period and 1841; showing a rapidly accelerated rate of destruction.411

Essex.—Harwich is said to have risen because of the destruction of Orwell, a town that used to be where “the west rocks” are now, which was wiped out by the sea since the Conquest. People fear that the narrow land where Harwich stands could soon become an island, as the sea may breach the area near Lower Dover Court, where Beacon Cliff consists of flat layers of London clay containing septaria. It eroded significantly between 1829 and 1838, during which time I examined the coast. In that short period, several gardens and many houses were washed away, and in April 1838, an entire street was on the verge of being destroyed. The advance of the sea is speeding up due to the traffic in septaria, which is shipped off for cement as quickly as it falls onto the beach. If these stones were left in piles along the shore, they would weaken the waves and slow down the process of the peninsula becoming an island, which could lead to the destruction of Harwich. Captain Washington, R. N., found out in 1847 that Beacon Cliff, mentioned earlier, which is about fifty feet tall, had eroded by forty feet over forty-seven years, from 1709 to 1756; eighty feet from 1756 to 1804; and three hundred and fifty feet from that time until 1841, indicating a rapidly increasing rate of erosion.411

Among other losses it is recorded that, since the year 1807, a field called the Vicar's Field, which belonged to the living of Harwich, has been overwhelmed;412 and in the year 1820 there was a considerable space between the battery at Harwich, built in the beginning of the present century, and the sea; part of the fortification had been swept away in 1829, and the rest then overhung the water.

Among other losses, it’s noted that since 1807, a field known as the Vicar's Field, which belonged to the parish of Harwich, has been submerged;412 and in 1820, there was a significant distance between the battery at Harwich, built at the start of this century, and the sea; part of the fortifications had been washed away in 1829, and the remainder then hung over the water.

At Walton Naze, in the same county, the cliffs, composed of London clay, capped by the shelly sands of the crag, reach the height of about 312 100 feet, and are annually undermined by the waves. The old churchyard of Walton has been washed away, and the cliffs to the south are constantly disappearing.

At Walton Naze, in the same county, the cliffs made of London clay, topped with sandy shells, reach about 312 100 feet high, and are eroded each year by the waves. The old churchyard in Walton has been washed away, and the cliffs to the south are constantly vanishing.

Kent.—Isle of Sheppey.—On the coast bounding the estuary of the Thames, there are numerous examples both of the gain and loss of land. The Isle of Sheppey, which is now about six miles long by four in breadth, is composed of London clay. The cliffs on the north, which are from sixty to eighty feet high, decay rapidly, fifty acres having been lost in twenty years, between 1810 and 1830. The church at Minster, now near the coast, is said to have been in the middle of the island in 1780; and if the present rate of destruction should continue, we might calculate the period, and that not a very remote one, when the whole island will be annihilated. On the coast of the mainland, to the east of Sheppey, is Herne Bay: a place still retaining the name of a bay, although it is no longer appropriate, as the waves and currents have swept away the ancient headlands. There was formerly a small promontory in the line of the shoals where the present pier is built, by which the larger bay was divided into two, called the Upper and Lower.413

Kent.—Isle of Sheppey.—On the coast along the estuary of the Thames, there are many examples of both land gaining and losing. The Isle of Sheppey, which is now about six miles long and four miles wide, is made up of London clay. The cliffs on the north, which rise from sixty to eighty feet high, erode quickly, with fifty acres lost in just twenty years, between 1810 and 1830. The church at Minster, which is now close to the coast, is said to have been in the center of the island in 1780; and if the current rate of erosion continues, we could estimate a timeline, and it wouldn’t be too far off, when the entire island could be wiped out. On the mainland coast east of Sheppey is Herne Bay: a place that still carries the name of a bay, even though it's no longer fitting, as the waves and currents have eroded the old headlands. There used to be a small promontory along the shoals where the current pier is located, which separated the larger bay into two parts, known as the Upper and Lower.413

Fig. 33.

Fig. 33.

View of Reculver Church, taken in the year 1781.

View of Reculver Church, taken in the year 1781.

View of Reculver Church, taken in 1781.

1. Isle of Sheppey. 2. Ancient chapel now destroyed. The cottage between this chapel and the cliff was demolished by the sea, in 1782.

1. Isle of Sheppey. 2. Ancient chapel now gone. The cottage between this chapel and the cliff was washed away by the sea in 1782.

Still farther east stands the church of Reculver, upon a cliff composed of clay and sand, about twenty-five feet high. Reculver (Regulvium) was an important military station in the time of the Romans, and appears, from Leland's account, to have been, so late as Henry VIII.'s reign, nearly one mile distant from the sea. In the "Gentleman's Magazine," there is a view of it, taken in 1781, which still represents a considerable space as intervening between the north wall of the churchyard and the cliff.414 Sometime before the year 1780, the waves had reached the site of the ancient Roman camp or fortification, the walls of which 313 had continued for several years after they were undermined to overhang the sea, being firmly cemented into one mass. They were eighty yards nearer the sea than the church, and they are spoken of in the "Topographica Britannica," in the year 1780, as having recently fallen down. In 1804, part of the churchyard with some adjoining houses was washed away, and the ancient church, with its two spires, was dismantled and abandoned as a place of worship, but kept in repair as a landmark well known to mariners. I visited the spot in June, 1851, and saw human bones and part of a wooden coffin projecting from the cliff, near the top. The whole building would probably have been swept away long ere this, had not the force of the waves been checked by an artificial causeway of stones and large wooden piles driven into the sands on the beach to break the force of the waves.

Further east stands the church of Reculver, perched on a cliff made of clay and sand, about twenty-five feet high. Reculver (Regulvium) was an important military station during Roman times and seems, based on Leland's account, to have been nearly a mile away from the sea as recently as Henry VIII's reign. In the "Gentleman's Magazine," there's a view of it taken in 1781 that still shows a significant distance between the north wall of the churchyard and the cliff.414 Sometime before 1780, the waves had reached the site of the old Roman camp or fortification, the walls of which had continued to overhang the sea for several years after being eroded, as they were tightly cemented together. They were eighty yards closer to the sea than the church and were mentioned in the "Topographica Britannica" in 1780 as having recently collapsed. In 1804, part of the churchyard and some nearby houses were washed away, and the ancient church, complete with its two spires, was decommissioned as a place of worship, although it was maintained as a well-known landmark for sailors. I visited the site in June 1851 and noticed human bones and part of a wooden coffin sticking out from the cliff near the top. The whole building would likely have been swept away long ago if the force of the waves hadn’t been reduced by an artificial causeway made of stones and large wooden piles driven into the sand on the beach to break the waves' power.

Fig. 34.Reculver Church, in 1834.

Reculver Church, in 1834.

Reculver Church, 1834.

Isle of Thanet.—The isle of Thanet was, in the time of the Romans, separated from the rest of Kent by a navigable channel, through which the Roman fleets sailed on their way to and from London. Bede describes this small estuary as being, in the beginning of the eighth century, three furlongs in breadth; and it is supposed that it began to grow shallow about the period of the Norman conquest. It was so far silted up in the year 1485, that an act was then obtained to build a bridge across it; and it has since become marsh land with small streams running through it. On the coast, Bedlam Farm, belonging to the hospital of that name, lost eight acres in the twenty years preceding 314 1830, the land being composed of chalk from forty to fifty feet above the level of the sea. It has been computed that the average waste of the cliff between the North Foreland and the Reculvers, a distance of about eleven miles, is not less than two feet per annum. The chalk cliffs on the south of Thanet, between Ramsgate and Pegwell Bay, have on an average lost three feet per annum for the last ten years (preceding 1830).

Isle of Thanet.—The Isle of Thanet was, during Roman times, separated from the rest of Kent by a navigable channel that Roman fleets used to travel to and from London. Bede describes this small estuary as being three furlongs wide at the beginning of the eighth century, and it’s believed to have started filling in with sediment around the time of the Norman conquest. By 1485, it had silted up enough that an act was passed to build a bridge across it, and it has since turned into marshland with small streams flowing through it. Along the coast, Bedlam Farm, which belongs to the hospital of the same name, lost eight acres in the twenty years leading up to 314 1830, with the land consisting of chalk located forty to fifty feet above sea level. It has been estimated that the average erosion of the cliff between North Foreland and the Reculvers, a distance of about eleven miles, is at least two feet per year. The chalk cliffs to the south of Thanet, between Ramsgate and Pegwell Bay, have lost an average of three feet per year over the past ten years (prior to 1830).

Goodwin Sands.—The Goodwin Sands lie opposite this part of the Kentish coast. They are about ten miles in length, and are in some parts three, and in others seven, miles distant from the shore; and, for a certain space, are laid bare at low water. That they are a remnant of land, and not "a mere accumulation of sea sand," as Rennell imagined,415 may be presumed from the fact that, when the erection of a lighthouse on this shoal was in contemplation by the Trinity Board in the year 1817, it was found, by borings, that the bank consisted of fifteen feet of sand, resting on blue clay; and, by subsequent borings, the subjacent chalk has been reached. An obscure tradition has come down to us, that the estates of Earl Goodwin, the father of Harold, who died in the year 1053, were situated here, and some have conjectured that they were overwhelmed by the flood mentioned in the Saxon chronicle, sub anno 1099. The last remains of an island, consisting, like Sheppey, of clay, may perhaps have been carried away about that time.

Goodwin Sands.—The Goodwin Sands are located off this part of the Kentish coast. They stretch about ten miles in length and are three miles from the shore in some areas and seven miles in others; they are exposed at low tide for a certain period. They are likely a remnant of land and not just "a mere accumulation of sea sand," as Rennell thought,415 as evidenced by borings taken when the Trinity Board contemplated building a lighthouse on this shoal in 1817, revealing that the bank was made of fifteen feet of sand on top of blue clay; further borings later reached the underlying chalk. A vague tradition has been passed down indicating that the estates of Earl Goodwin, the father of Harold, who died in 1053, were located here, and some believe that they were submerged in the flood mentioned in the Saxon chronicle, sub anno 1099. The last remnants of an island, made of clay like Sheppey, may have disappeared around that time.

Fig. 35.

Fig. 35.

Shakspeare's Cliff in 1836, seen from the northeast.

Shakspeare's Cliff in 1836, seen from the northeast.

Shakespeare's Cliff in 1836, viewed from the northeast.

There are other records of waste in the county of Kent, as at Deal; and at Dover, where Shakspeare's Cliff, composed entirely of chalk, has suffered greatly, and continually diminishes in height, the slope of the hill being towards the land. (See fig. 35.) There was an immense landslip from this cliff in 1810, by which Dover was shaken as if by an 315 earthquake, and a still greater one in 1772.416 We may suppose, therefore, that the view from the top of the precipice in the year 1600, when the tragedy of King Lear was written, was more "fearful and dizzy" than it is now. The best antiquarian authorities are agreed, that Dover Harbor was formerly an estuary, the sea flowing up a valley between the chalk hills. The remains found in different excavations confirm the description of the spot given by Cæsar and Antoninus, and there is clear historical evidence to prove that at an early period there was no shingle at all at Dover.417

There are other records of erosion in Kent, like at Deal; and at Dover, where Shakespeare's Cliff, made entirely of chalk, has been seriously impacted and is steadily losing height, with the slope of the hill pointing towards the land. (See fig. 35.) In 1810, there was a huge landslip from this cliff that shook Dover like an earthquake, with an even bigger one occurring in 1772.416 We can assume, therefore, that the view from the top of the cliff in 1600, when the tragedy of King Lear was written, was more "fearful and dizzy" than it is today. The best historical experts agree that Dover Harbor was once an estuary, with the sea flowing up a valley between the chalk hills. The remains found in various excavations support the description of the area given by Caesar and Antoninus, and there is solid historical evidence showing that there was no shingle at all in Dover during an early period.417

Straits of Dover.—In proceeding from the northern parts of the German Ocean towards the Straits of Dover, the water becomes gradually more shallow, so that, in the distance of about two hundred leagues, we pass from a depth of 120 to that of 58, 38, 18, and even less than 2 fathoms. The shallowest part follows a line drawn between Romney Marsh and Boulogne. From this point the English Channel again deepens progressively as we proceed westward, so that the Straits of Dover may be said to part two seas.418

Straits of Dover.—When moving from the northern parts of the German Ocean toward the Straits of Dover, the water gradually gets shallower. Over a distance of about two hundred leagues, the depth decreases from 120 to 58, then 38, 18, and even less than 2 fathoms. The shallowest section follows a line drawn between Romney Marsh and Boulogne. From this point, the English Channel becomes deeper again as we continue westward, so we can say that the Straits of Dover separate two seas.418

Whether England was formerly united with France has often been a favorite subject of speculation. So early as 1605 our countryman Verstegan, in his "Antiquities of the English Nation," observed that many preceding writers had maintained this opinion, but without supporting it by any weighty reasons. He accordingly endeavors himself to confirm it by various arguments, the principal of which are, first, the proximity and identity of the composition of the opposite cliffs and shores of Albion and Gallia, which, whether flat and sandy, or steep and chalky, correspond exactly with each other; secondly the occurrence of a submarine ridge, called "our Lady's Sand," extending from shore to shore at no great depth, and which, from its composition, appears to be the original basis of the isthmus; thirdly, the identity of the noxious animals in France and England, which could neither have swum across, nor have been introduced by man. Thus no one, he says, would have imported wolves, therefore "these wicked beasts did of themselves pass over." He supposes the ancient isthmus to have been about six English miles in breadth, composed entirely of chalk and flint, and in some places of no great height above the sea-level. The operation of the waves and tides, he says, would have been more powerful when the straits were narrower, and even now they are destroying cliffs composed of similar materials. He suggests the possible co-operation of earthquakes; and when we consider how many submarine forests skirt the southern and eastern shores of England, and that there are raised beaches at many points above the sea-level, containing fossil shells of recent species, it seems reasonable to suppose that such upward 316 now in progress in Sweden and Greenland, may have greatly assisted the denuding force of "the ocean stream," Ποταμοιο μεγα σθενος Ωχεανοτο.

Whether England was ever connected to France has often been a popular topic of discussion. As early as 1605, our fellow countryman Verstegan, in his "Antiquities of the English Nation," noted that many earlier writers supported this idea, but without providing any strong evidence. He then attempts to back it up with various arguments, the main ones being, first, the closeness and similarity of the cliffs and shores of Albion and Gallia, which, whether they're flat and sandy or steep and chalky, match up perfectly; second, the presence of an underwater ridge called "our Lady's Sand," stretching from shore to shore at a shallow depth, which seems to be the original base of the land bridge; third, the similarity of harmful animals in both France and England, which couldn't have swum across nor been brought by humans. Thus, he argues that no one would have brought in wolves, so "these wicked beasts must have crossed over by themselves." He believes the ancient land bridge was about six English miles wide, made entirely of chalk and flint, and in some areas was not very high above sea level. He states that wave and tide action would have been stronger when the straits were narrower, and even now they are eroding cliffs made of similar materials. He also suggests the potential impact of earthquakes; and when we consider how many underwater forests line the southern and eastern shores of England, and that there are raised beaches at various spots above sea level containing fossil shells of recent species, it seems reasonable to think that such upward movements, 316 now taking place in Sweden and Greenland, may have significantly aided the eroding power of "the ocean stream," Ποταμοιο μεγα σθενος Ωχεανοτο.

Folkstone.—At Folkstone, the sea undermines the chalk and subjacent strata. About the year 1716 there was a remarkable sinking of a tract of land near the sea, so that houses became visible from certain points at sea, and from particular spots on the sea cliffs, from whence they could not be seen previously. In the description of this subsidence in the Phil. Trans. 1716, it is said, "that the land consisted of a solid stony mass (chalk), resting on wet clay (gault), so that it slid forwards towards the sea, just as a ship is launched on tallowed planks." It is also stated that, within the memory of persons then living, the cliff there had been washed away to the extent of ten rods.

Folkstone.—At Folkstone, the sea erodes the chalk and underlying layers. Around the year 1716, a significant piece of land near the sea sank, making some houses visible from certain points at sea and from specific spots on the cliffs where they had been hidden before. In the report of this subsidence in the Phil. Trans. 1716, it states, "the land was made up of a solid stony mass (chalk), sitting on wet clay (gault), which caused it to slide forward towards the sea, just like a ship sliding down greased planks." It was also noted that, within the memory of people who were alive at the time, the cliff had eroded by as much as ten rods.

Encroachments of the sea at Hythe are also on record; but between this point and Rye there has been a gain of land within the times of history; the rich level tract called Romney Marsh, or Dungeness, about ten miles in width and five in breadth, and formed of silt, having received great accession. It has been necessary, however, to protect it from the sea, from the earliest periods, by embankments, the towns of Lydd and Romney being the only parts of the marsh above the level of the highest tides.419 Mr. Redman has cited numerous old charts and trustworthy authorities to prove that the average annual increase of the promontory of shingle called Dungeness amounted for two centuries, previous to 1844, to nearly six yards. Its progress, however, has fluctuated during that period; for between 1689 and 1794, a term of 105 years, the rate was as much as 8-1/4 yards per annum.420 It is ascertained that the shingle is derived from the westward. Whether the pebbles are stopped by the meeting of the tide from the north flowing through the Straits of Dover, with that which comes up the Channel from the west, as was formerly held, or by the check given to the tidal current by the waters of the Rother, as some maintain, is still a disputed question.

Encroachments of the sea at Hythe have been documented; however, between this point and Rye, there has been a gain of land throughout history. The fertile area known as Romney Marsh, or Dungeness, is about ten miles wide and five miles long, made up of silt, and has seen significant expansion. It has been necessary, though, to protect it from the sea with embankments from the earliest times, with the towns of Lydd and Romney being the only parts of the marsh that are above the highest tides.419 Mr. Redman has referenced several old maps and reliable sources to show that the average annual increase of the shingle promontory called Dungeness was nearly six yards for two centuries before 1844. However, its rate of growth has varied during that time; for instance, between 1689 and 1794, a span of 105 years, the rate was as much as 8-1/4 yards per year.420 It is confirmed that the shingle comes from the west. Whether the pebbles are caught by the meeting of the tide streaming north through the Straits of Dover and that which flows up the Channel from the west, as was previously believed, or by the resistance encountered by the tidal current from the waters of the Rother, as some argue, remains a debated issue.

Rye, situated to the south of Romney Marsh, was once destroyed by the sea, but it is now two miles distant from it. The neighboring town of Winchelsea was destroyed in the reign of Edward I., the mouth of the Rother stopped up, and the river diverted into another channel. In its old bed, an ancient vessel, apparently a Dutch merchantman, was found about the year 1824. It was built entirely of oak, and much blackened.421 Large quantities of hazel-nuts, peat, and wood are found in digging in Romney Marsh.

Rye, located south of Romney Marsh, was once wiped out by the sea, but now it's two miles away from it. The nearby town of Winchelsea was destroyed during the reign of Edward I, when the mouth of the Rother got blocked and the river was rerouted. In its old channel, an ancient ship, likely a Dutch merchant vessel, was discovered around 1824. It was constructed entirely of oak and was heavily charred.421 Large amounts of hazelnuts, peat, and wood are found when digging in Romney Marsh.

South coast of England.—Westward of Hastings, or of St. Leonard's, the shore line has been giving way as far as Pevensey Bay, where formerly there existed a haven now entirely blocked up by shingle. The 317 degradation has equalled for a series of years seven feet per annum in some places, and several martello towers had in consequence, before 1851, been removed by the Ordnance.422 At the promontory of Beachy Head a mass of chalk, three hundred feet in length, and from seventy to eighty in breadth, fell in the year 1813 with a tremendous crash; and similar slips have since been frequent.423

South coast of England.—West of Hastings or St. Leonard's, the coastline has been eroding all the way to Pevensey Bay, where a harbor that used to exist is now completely blocked by shingle. The erosion has been about seven feet per year in some areas for several years, and as a result, several martello towers were removed by the Ordnance before 1851.422 At Beachy Head, a chalk cliff that was three hundred feet long and seventy to eighty feet wide collapsed in 1813 with a huge crash, and similar landslides have happened frequently since then.423

About a mile to the west of the town of Newhaven, the remains of an ancient intrenchment are seen on the brow of Castle Hill. This earthwork, supposed to be Roman, was evidently once of considerable extent and of an oval form, but the greater part has been cut away by the sea. The cliffs, which are undermined here, are high; more than one hundred feet of chalk being covered by tertiary clay and sand, from sixty to seventy feet in thickness. In a few centuries the last vestiges of the plastic clay formation on the southern borders of the chalk of the South Downs on this coast will probably be annihilated, and future geologists will learn, from historical documents, the ancient geographical boundaries of this group of strata in that direction. On the opposite side of the estuary of the Ouse, on the east of Newhaven harbor, a bed of shingle, composed of chalk flints derived from the waste of the adjoining cliffs, had accumulated at Seaford for several centuries. In the great storm of November, 1824, this bank was entirely swept away, and the town of Seaford inundated. Another great beach of shingle is now forming from fresh materials.

About a mile to the west of Newhaven, you can see the remains of an ancient fortification on Castle Hill. This earthwork, believed to be Roman, was clearly once quite extensive and oval in shape, but most of it has been eroded away by the sea. The cliffs here are steep and undercut, rising more than one hundred feet, with over sixty to seventy feet of chalk covered by tertiary clay and sand. In a few centuries, the last traces of the clay formation along the southern edge of the chalk of the South Downs on this coast will likely be gone, and future geologists will have to rely on historical documents to understand the ancient geographical boundaries of this rock group in that area. On the other side of the Ouse estuary, east of Newhaven harbor, a beach made up of chalk flints from the nearby cliffs has built up at Seaford for several centuries. During the massive storm in November 1824, this bank was completely washed away, flooding the town of Seaford. Now, another significant shingle beach is forming from new materials.

The whole coast of Sussex has been incessantly encroached upon by the sea from time immemorial; and, although sudden inundations only, which overwhelmed fertile or inhabited tracts, are noticed in history, the records attest an extraordinary amount of loss. During a period of no more than eighty years, there are notices of about twenty inroads, in which tracts of land of from twenty to four hundred acres in extent were overwhelmed at once, the value of the tithes being mentioned in the Taxatio Ecclesiastica.424 In the reign of Elizabeth, the town of Brighton was situated on that tract where the chain pier now extends into the sea. In the year 1665, twenty-two tenements had been destroyed under the cliff. At that period there still remained under the cliff 113 tenements, the whole of which were overwhelmed in 1703 and 1705. No traces of the ancient town are now perceptible, yet there is evidence that the sea has merely resumed its ancient position at the base of the cliffs, the site of the whole town having been merely a beach abandoned by the ocean for ages.

The entire coast of Sussex has been constantly eaten away by the sea for as long as anyone can remember; and while only sudden floods that swept over fertile or populated areas are documented in history, the records show an incredible amount of loss. In just eighty years, there are records of about twenty instances where land areas ranging from twenty to four hundred acres were submerged all at once, with the value of the tithes noted in the Taxatio Ecclesiastica.424 During Elizabeth's reign, the town of Brighton was located on the land where the chain pier now reaches into the sea. In 1665, twenty-two buildings were destroyed below the cliff. At that time, there were still 113 buildings remaining under the cliff, all of which were submerged in 1703 and 1705. No signs of the old town are visible now, but there is evidence that the sea has simply returned to its former position at the base of the cliffs, with the entire town site being just a beach that the ocean had left behind for ages.

Hampshire.—Isle of Wight.—It would be endless to allude to all the localities on the Sussex and Hampshire coasts where the land has given way; but I may point out the relation which the geological structure of the Isle of Wight bears to its present shape, as attesting that the 318 coast owes its outline to the continued action of the sea. Through the middle of the island runs a high ridge of chalk strata, in a vertical position, and in a direction east and west. This chalk forms the projecting promontory of Culver Cliff on the east, and of the Needles on the west; while Sandown Bay on the one side, and Compton Bay on the other, have been hollowed out of the softer sands and argillaceous strata, which are inferior, in geological position, to the chalk.

Hampshire.—Isle of Wight.—It would take forever to mention all the places along the Sussex and Hampshire coasts where the land has eroded; however, I can highlight how the geological structure of the Isle of Wight relates to its current shape, showing that the 318 coastline owes its outline to the ongoing action of the sea. A high ridge of chalk runs through the middle of the island, standing vertically and extending from east to west. This chalk forms the protruding cliffs of Culver Cliff on the east and the Needles on the west; meanwhile, Sandown Bay on one side and Compton Bay on the other have been carved out of the softer sands and clay layers, which are situated lower in the geological hierarchy than the chalk.

The same phenomena are repeated in the Isle of Purbeck, where the line of vertical chalk forms the projecting promontory of Handfast Point; and Swanage Bay marks the deep excavation made by the waves in the softer strata, corresponding to those of Sandown Bay.

The same phenomena occur in the Isle of Purbeck, where the vertical chalk line forms the jutting promontory of Handfast Point, and Swanage Bay reflects the deep erosion caused by the waves in the softer layers, similar to those in Sandown Bay.

Hurst Castle bank—progressive motion of sea beaches.—Although the loose pebbles and grains of sand composing any given line of sea-beach are carried sometimes one way, sometimes another, they have, nevertheless, an ultimate motion in one particular direction.425 Their progress, for example, on the south coast of England, is from west to east, which is owing partly to the action of the waves driven eastwards by the prevailing wind, and partly to the current, or the motion of the general body of water caused by the tides and winds. The force of the waves gives motion to pebbles which the velocity of the currents alone would be unable to carry forwards; but as the pebbles are finally reduced to sand or mud, by continual attrition, they are brought within the influence of a current; and this cause must determine the course which the main body of matter derived from wasting cliffs will eventually take.

Hurst Castle bank—movement of sea beaches.—Even though the loose pebbles and grains of sand that make up any section of sea beach may be moved in different directions at times, they ultimately shift in one specific direction.425 For instance, along the south coast of England, their movement is from west to east, which is partly due to the waves being pushed eastward by the dominant wind and partly due to the current, or the movement of the main body of water affected by the tides and winds. The power of the waves sets the pebbles in motion, which the speed of the currents alone couldn’t carry forward; but as the pebbles gradually break down into sand or mud through constant wear, they fall under the influence of a current, and this factor must dictate the path that the main body of material from eroding cliffs will eventually follow.

It appears, from the observations of Mr. Palmer and others, that if a pier or groin be erected anywhere on our southern or southeastern coast to stop the progress of the beach, a heap of shingle soon collects on the western side of such artificial barriers. The pebbles continue to accumulate till they rise as high as the pier or groin, after which they pour over in great numbers during heavy gales.426

It seems, based on the observations of Mr. Palmer and others, that if a pier or groin is built anywhere on our southern or southeastern coast to stop the beach from eroding, a pile of shingles quickly gathers on the western side of these man-made barriers. The pebbles keep building up until they reach the height of the pier or groin, after which they spill over in large amounts during strong storms.426

The western entrance of the Channel, called the Solent, is crossed for more than two-thirds of its width by the shingle-bank of Hurst Castle, which is about two miles long, seventy yards broad, and twelve feet high, presenting an inclined plane to the west. This singular bar consists of a bed of rounded chalk flints, resting on a submarine argillaceous base. The flints and a few other pebbles, intermixed, are derived from the waste of Hordwell, and other cliffs to the westward, where tertiary strata, capped with a covering of broken chalk flints, from five to fifty feet thick, are rapidly undermined. In the great storm of November, 1824, this bank of shingle was moved bodily forwards for forty yards towards the northeast; and certain piles, which served to mark the boundaries of two manors, were found after the storm on the opposite side of the bar. At the same time many acres of pasture land were 319 covered by shingle, on the farm of Westover, near Lymington. But the bar was soon restored in its old position by pebbles drifted from the west; and it appears from ancient maps that it has preserved the same general outline and position for centuries.427

The western entrance of the Channel, known as the Solent, is crossed for over two-thirds of its width by the shingle bank of Hurst Castle, which is about two miles long, seventy yards wide, and twelve feet high, creating a slope to the west. This unique formation is made up of a bed of rounded chalk flints sitting on a submarine clay base. The flints, along with a few other pebbles, come from the erosion of Hordwell and other cliffs to the west, where layers of tertiary rock topped with broken chalk flints, five to fifty feet thick, are quickly being worn away. During the major storm in November 1824, this shingle bank was pushed forward by forty yards toward the northeast, and some posts that marked the boundaries of two manors were found on the other side of the bar after the storm. At the same time, many acres of pasture on the Westover farm near Lymington were covered by shingle. However, the bar was quickly restored to its original position by pebbles washed in from the west, and historical maps show that it has maintained the same general shape and location for centuries.319

Mr. Austen remarks that, as a general rule, it is only when high tides concur with a gale of wind, that the sea reaches the base of cliffs so as to undermine them and throw down earth and stone. But the waves are perpetually employed in abrading and fashioning the materials already strewed over the beach. Much of the gravel and shingle is always travelling up and down, between high-water mark and a slight depth below the level of the lowest tides, and occasionally the materials are swept away and carried into deeper water. Owing to these movements every portion of our southern coast may be seen at one time or other in the condition of bare rock. Yet other beds of sand and shingle soon collect, and, although composed of new materials, invariably exhibit on the same spots precisely similar characters.428

Mr. Austen notes that generally, the sea only reaches the base of cliffs to erode them and cause landslides when high tides coincide with a strong wind. However, the waves are constantly working to wear down and shape the materials already scattered along the beach. A lot of the gravel and pebbles are always moving back and forth between the high-water line and just below the lowest tide level, and sometimes these materials get washed away into deeper water. Because of these movements, every part of our southern coast can be seen at one time or another as bare rock. Yet, new layers of sand and pebbles quickly form, and even though they consist of different materials, they always show the same characteristics in the same locations.428

The cliffs between Hurst Shingle Bar and Christchurch are undermined continually, the sea having often encroached for a series of years at the rate of a yard annually. Within the memory of persons now living, it has been necessary thrice to remove the coast-road farther inland. The tradition, therefore, is probably true, that the church of Hordwell was once in the middle of that parish, although now (1830) very near the sea. The promontory of Christchurch Head gives way slowly. It is the only point between Lymington and Poole Harbor, in Dorsetshire, where any hard stony masses occur in the cliffs. Five layers of large ferruginous concretions, somewhat like the septaria of the London clay, have occasioned a resistance at this point, to which we may ascribe this headland. In the mean time, the waves have cut deeply into the soft sands and loam of Poole Bay; and, after severe frosts, great landslips take place, which by degrees become enlarged into narrow ravines, or chines, as they are called, with vertical sides. One of these chines, near Boscomb, has been deepened twenty feet within a few years. At the head of each there is a spring, the waters of which have been chiefly instrumental in producing these narrow excavations, which are sometimes from 100 to 150 feet deep.

The cliffs between Hurst Shingle Bar and Christchurch are constantly eroding, with the sea encroaching by about a yard each year for several years. Within the memory of people alive today, it has been necessary to move the coast road further inland three times. So, the tradition likely holds true that the church of Hordwell was once in the center of that parish, although now (1830) it is very close to the sea. Christchurch Head is eroding slowly. It's the only place between Lymington and Poole Harbor, in Dorsetshire, where any solid rock formations can be found in the cliffs. Five layers of large rusty concretions, similar to the septaria of the London clay, have created a resistance at this point, which forms this headland. Meanwhile, the waves have cut deep into the soft sands and loam of Poole Bay; and after severe frosts, large landslips occur, gradually developing into narrow ravines, or chines, as they are called, with steep sides. One of these chines, near Boscomb, has deepened by twenty feet in just a few years. At the head of each of these ravines, there is a spring, whose waters have largely contributed to creating these narrow excavations, which can be anywhere from 100 to 150 feet deep.

Isle of Portland.—The peninsulas of Purbeck and Portland are continually wasting away. In the latter, the soft argillaceous substratum (Kimmeridge clay) hastens the dilapidation of the superincumbent mass of limestone.

Isle of Portland.—The peninsulas of Purbeck and Portland are continuously eroding. In Portland, the soft clay base (Kimmeridge clay) speeds up the deterioration of the limestone that sits above it.

In 1655 the cliffs adjoining the principal quarries in Portland gave way to the extent of one hundred yards, and fell into the sea; and in December, 1734, a slide to the extent of 150 yards occurred on the east side of the isle, by which several skeletons buried between slabs of stone, were discovered. But a much more memorable occurrence of 320 this nature, in 1792, occasioned probably by the undermining of the cliffs, is thus described in Hutchin's History of Dorsetshire:—"Early in the morning the road was observed to crack: this continued increasing, and before two o'clock the ground had sunk several feet, and was in one continued motion, but attended with no other noise than what was occasioned by the separation of the roots and brambles, and now and then a falling rock. At night it seemed to stop a little, but soon moved again; and, before morning, the ground from the top of the cliff to the waterside had sunk in some places fifty feet perpendicular. The extent of ground that moved was about a mile and a quarter from north to south, and 600 yards from east to west."

In 1655, the cliffs next to the main quarries in Portland collapsed by about a hundred yards and fell into the sea. Then, in December 1734, a slip on the east side of the island covered 150 yards, revealing several skeletons buried between stone slabs. But a much more notable event of this kind occurred in 1792, likely due to the erosion of the cliffs. Hutchin's History of Dorsetshire describes it like this: "Early in the morning, the road started to crack. This continued to grow worse, and by two o'clock, the ground had sunk several feet, moving continuously but only making noise from the separation of roots and brambles, along with the occasional falling rock. At night, it seemed to pause for a bit, but soon started moving again, and by morning, the ground from the top of the cliff to the water had sunk as much as fifty feet in some areas. The area that shifted was about a mile and a quarter long from north to south and 600 yards wide from east to west."

Formation of the Chesil Bank.—Portland is connected with the mainland by the Chesil Bank, a ridge of shingle about seventeen miles in length, and, in most places, nearly a quarter of a mile in breadth. The pebbles forming this immense barrier are chiefly siliceous, all loosely thrown together, and rising to the height of from twenty to thirty feet above the ordinary high-water mark; and at the southeastern end, which is nearest the Isle of Portland, where the pebbles are largest, forty feet. The fundamental rocks whereon the shingle rests are found at the depth of a few yards only below the level of the sea. The formation of that part of the bar which attaches Portland to the mainland may have been due to an original shoal or reef, or to the set of the tides in the narrow channel, by which the course of the pebbles, which are always coming from the west, has been arrested. It is a singular fact that, throughout the Chesil Bank, the pebbles increase gradually in size as we proceed southeastward, or as we go farther from the quarter which supplied them. Had the case been reversed, we should naturally have attributed the circumstance to the constant wearing down of the pebbles by friction, as they are rolled along a beach seventeen miles in length. But the true explanation of the phenomenon is doubtless this: the tidal current runs strongest from west to east, and its power is greater in the more open channel or farther from the land. In other words its force increases southwards, and as the direction of the bank is from northwest to southeast, the size of the masses coming from the westward and thrown ashore must always be largest where the motion of the water is most violent. Colonel Reid states that all calcareous stones rolled along from the west are soon ground into sand, and in this form they pass round Portland Island.429

Formation of the Chesil Bank.—Portland is connected to the mainland by Chesil Bank, a ridge of pebbles about seventeen miles long and nearly a quarter of a mile wide in most places. The pebbles that make up this massive barrier are mainly siliceous, loosely packed together, and rise to a height of twenty to thirty feet above the normal high-water mark; at the southeastern end, closest to the Isle of Portland, where the pebbles are largest, they reach forty feet. The underlying rocks supporting the shingle are found just a few yards below sea level. The section of the bank that connects Portland to the mainland may have formed from an original shoal or reef or due to the tidal flow in the narrow channel, which has stopped the movement of the pebbles that constantly come from the west. Interestingly, along the Chesil Bank, the pebbles gradually increase in size as you head southeast, moving away from the area they originated from. If the reverse were true, we might think this was because the pebbles were continually worn down by friction as they rolled along a seventeen-mile beach. However, the real reason for this phenomenon is likely that the tidal current flows strongest from west to east, with more power in the wider channel further from land. In other words, the current's force increases towards the south, and since the bank runs from northwest to southeast, the pebbles coming from the west and washed ashore must always be largest where the water moves the fastest. Colonel Reid mentions that all calcareous stones that are rolled in from the west quickly get ground into sand, and this sand then circles around Portland Island.429

The storm of 1824 burst over the Chesil Bank with great fury, and the village of Chesilton, built upon its southern extremity, was overwhelmed, with many of the inhabitants. The same storm carried away part of the Breakwater at Plymouth, and huge masses of rock, from two to five tons in weight, were lifted from the bottom of the weather side, and rolled fairly to the top of the pile. One block of limestone, 321 weighing seven tons, was washed round the western extremity of the Breakwater, and carried 150 feet.430 The propelling power is derived in these cases from the breaking of the waves, which run fastest in shallow water, and for a short space far exceed the most rapid currents in swiftness. It was in the same month, and also during a spring-tide, that a great flood is mentioned on the coasts of England, in the year 1099. Florence of Worcester says, "On the third day of the nones of Nov. 1099, the sea came out upon the shore and buried towns and men very many, and oxen and sheep innumerable." We also read in the Saxon Chronicle, for the year 1099, "This year eke on St. Martin's mass day, the 11th of Novembre, sprung up so much of the sea flood, and so myckle harm did, as no man minded that it ever afore did, and there was the ylk day a new moon."

The storm of 1824 hit the Chesil Bank with intense force, and the village of Chesilton, located at its southern end, was completely flooded, along with many of its residents. This same storm damaged part of the Breakwater at Plymouth, lifting massive rocks weighing between two and five tons from the bottom of the weather side and rolling them up to the top. One limestone block, weighing seven tons, was washed around the western end of the Breakwater and carried 150 feet. The driving force behind this is the crashing waves, which move fastest in shallow water and can briefly outpace even the strongest currents. In that same month, during a spring tide, there was a significant flood along the coasts of England in 1099. Florence of Worcester notes, "On the third day of the nones of November 1099, the sea came ashore and buried many towns and people, along with countless oxen and sheep." The Saxon Chronicle for the year 1099 also states, "This year, on St. Martin's Mass day, the 11th of November, there was such a flood from the sea that it caused more harm than anyone could remember, and it happened on the same day as a new moon."

South of the Bill, or southern point of Portland, is a remarkable shoal in the channel at the depth of seven fathoms, called "the Shambles," consisting entirely of rolled and broken shells of Purpura lapillus, Mytilus edulis, and other species now living. This mass of light materials is always in motion, varying in height from day to day, and yet the shoal remains constant.

South of the Bill, or southern point of Portland, is an impressive sandbar in the channel at a depth of seven fathoms, known as "the Shambles." It is made entirely of rolled and broken shells from Purpura lapillus, Mytilus edulis, and other living species. This pile of light materials is always shifting, changing in height from day to day, yet the sandbar itself remains stable.

Dorsetshire.—Devonshire.—At Lyme Regis, in Dorsetshire, the "Church Cliffs," as they are called, consisting of lias about one hundred feet in height, gradually fell away at the rate of one yard a year, from 1800 to 1829.431

Dorsetshire.—Devonshire.—At Lyme Regis in Dorsetshire, the "Church Cliffs," which are made of lias and stand about one hundred feet tall, eroded at a rate of one yard per year from 1800 to 1829.431

Fig. 36.Landslip, near Axmouth, Dec. 1839. (Rev. W. D. Conybeare.)

Landslip, near Axmouth, Dec. 1839. (Rev. W. D. Conybeare.)

Landslip, near Axmouth, Dec. 1839. (Rev. W. D. Conybeare.)

A. Tract of Downs still remaining at their original level.

A. Tract of Downs still remaining at their original level.

B. New ravine.

B. New valley.

C, D. Sunk and fractured strip united to A, before the convulsion.

C, D. Sunk and broken strip connected to A, before the upheaval.

D, E. Bendon undercliff as before, but more fissured, and thrust forward about fifty feet, towards the sea.

D, E. Bendon undercliff as before, but more cracked, and pushed forward about fifty feet, toward the sea.

F. Pyramidal crag, sunk from seventy to twenty feet in height.

F. Pyramidal cliff, reduced from seventy to twenty feet high.

G. New reef upheaved from the sea.

G. A new reef has emerged from the sea.

An extraordinary landslip occurred on the 24th of December, 1839, on the coast between Lyme Regis and Axmouth, which has been described by the Rev. W. D. Conybeare, to whose kindness I am indebted for the accompanying section, fig. 36. The tract of downs ranging 322 there along the coast is capped by chalk (h), which rests on sandstone, alternating with chert (i), beneath which is more than 100 feet of loose sand (k), with concretions at the bottom, and belonging like i to the green-sand formation; the whole of the above masses, h, i, k, reposing on retentive beds of clay (l), belonging to the lias, which shelves towards the sea. Numerous springs issuing from the loose sand (k), have gradually removed portions of it, and thus undermined the superstratum, so as to have caused subsidences at former times, and to have produced a line of undercliff between D and E. In 1839 an excessively wet season had saturated all the rocks with moisture, so as to increase the weight of the incumbent mass, from which the support had already been withdrawn by the action of springs. Thus the superstrata were precipitated into hollows prepared for them, and the adjacent masses of partially undermined rock, to which the movement was communicated, were made to slide down on a slippery basis of watery sand towards the sea. These causes gave rise to a convulsion, which began on the morning of the 24th of December, with a crashing noise; and, on the evening of the same day, fissures were seen opening in the ground, and the walls of tenements rending and sinking, until a deep chasm or ravine, B, was formed, extending nearly three-quarters of a mile in length, with a depth of from 100 to 150 feet, and a breadth exceeding 240 feet. At the bottom of this deep gulf lie fragments of the original surface thrown together in the wildest confusion. In consequence of lateral movements, the tract intervening between the new fissure and the sea, including the ancient undercliff, was fractured, and the whole line of sea-cliff carried bodily forwards for many yards. "A remarkable pyramidal crag, F, off Culverhole Point, which lately formed a distinguishing landmark, has sunk from a height of about seventy to twenty feet, and the main cliff, E, before more than fifty feet distant from this insulated crag, is now brought almost close to it. This motion of the sea-cliff has produced a farther effect, which may rank among the most striking phenomena of this catastrophe. The lateral pressure of the descending rocks has urged the neighboring strata, extending beneath the shingle of the shore, by their state of unnatural condensation, to burst upwards in a line parallel to the coast—thus an elevated ridge, G, more than a mile in length, and rising more than forty feet, covered by a confused assemblage of broken strata, and immense blocks of rock, invested with sea-weed and corallines, and scattered over with shells and star-fish, and other productions of the deep, forms an extended reef in front of the present range of cliffs."432

An extraordinary landslide happened on December 24, 1839, on the coast between Lyme Regis and Axmouth, which has been described by Rev. W. D. Conybeare, to whom I owe thanks for the accompanying section, fig. 36. The range of hills along the coast is capped by chalk (h), resting on sandstone that alternates with chert (i), underneath which is over 100 feet of loose sand (k) with concretions at the bottom, also part of the green-sand formation; all these layers, h, i, k, sit on clay beds (l) from the lias, sloping towards the sea. Numerous springs emerging from the loose sand (k) have gradually eroded parts of it, undermining the upper layers and causing subsidence in the past, which created a line of undercliff between D and E. In 1839, an excessively wet season had saturated all the rocks with moisture, increasing the weight of the materials above, which had already been weakened by the springs. As a result, the upper layers collapsed into prepared hollows, with partially undermined rock masses sliding down on a slippery base of wet sand toward the sea. These factors triggered a disturbance that began on the morning of December 24, with a crashing sound; by that evening, cracks appeared in the ground, and the walls of buildings began to break and sink, forming a deep chasm or ravine, B, extending nearly three-quarters of a mile in length, with a depth of 100 to 150 feet, and a width of over 240 feet. At the bottom of this deep gully, fragments of the original surface are thrown together in chaotic disorder. Due to lateral movements, the area between the new fissure and the sea, including the old undercliff, fractured, and the entire line of sea-cliff moved forward by many yards. "A remarkable pyramidal crag, F, off Culverhole Point, which had recently been a distinctive landmark, has sunk from a height of about seventy feet to twenty feet, and the main cliff, E, which was formerly more than fifty feet away from this isolated crag, is now almost right next to it. This shift of the sea cliff has resulted in another effect, which can be considered one of the most striking phenomena of this disaster. The lateral pressure of the falling rocks has forced the nearby layers beneath the shore’s shingle, due to their unnatural compression, to burst upwards in a line parallel to the coast—creating an elevated ridge, G, over a mile long, rising more than forty feet, covered with a chaotic mix of broken strata and huge blocks of rock, detailed with seaweed and corallines, and scattered with shells, starfish, and other marine life, forming an extensive reef in front of the current cliffs."432

A full account of this remarkable landslip, with a plan, sections, and many fine illustrative drawings, was published by Messrs. Conybeare and Buckland,433 from one of which the annexed cut has been reduced, fig. 37.

A complete description of this amazing landslide, including a plan, sections, and several impressive illustrations, was published by Messrs. Conybeare and Buckland,433 from which the attached image has been scaled down, fig. 37.

Fig. 37.View of the Axmouth landslip from Great Bindon,

View of the Axmouth landslip from Great Bindon, looking westward to the Sidmouth hills, and estuary of the Exe. From an original drawing by Mrs. Buckland.

View of the Axmouth landslide from Great Bindon, looking west toward the Sidmouth hills and the Exe estuary. From an original drawing by Mrs. Buckland.

Cornwall.—Near Penzance, in Cornwall, there is a projecting tongue of land, called the "Green," formed of granitic sand, from which more than thirty acres of pasture land have been gradually swept away, in the course of the last two or three centuries.434 It is also said that St. Michael's Mount, now an insular rock, was formerly situated in a wood, several miles from the sea; and its old Cornish name (Caraclowse in Cowse) signifies, according to Carew, the Hoar Rock in the wood.435 Between the Mount and Newlyn there is seen under the sand, black vegetable mould, full of hazel-nuts, and the branches, leaves, roots, and trunks of forest-trees, all of indigenous species. This stratum has been traced seaward as far as the ebb permits, and many proofs of a submerged vegetable accumulation, with stumps of trees in the position in which they grew, have been traced, says Sir Henry De la Beche, round the shores of Devon, Cornwall, and Western Somerset. The facts not only indicate a change in the relative level of the sea and land, since the species of animals and plants were the same as those now living in this district; but, what is very remarkable, there seems evidence of the submergence having been effected, in part at least, since the country was inhabited by man.436

Cornwall.—Near Penzance, in Cornwall, there’s a piece of land called the "Green," which is made up of granitic sand. Over the past two or three centuries, more than thirty acres of pasture have gradually been eroded away.434 It’s also said that St. Michael's Mount, which is now an island, used to be part of a forest several miles from the sea; its old Cornish name (Caraclowse in Cowse) means, according to Carew, the Hoar Rock in the wood.435 Between the Mount and Newlyn, under the sand, you can find black vegetable soil filled with hazelnuts, along with branches, leaves, roots, and trunks of native trees. This layer has been traced out to sea as far as the tide allows, and many signs of submerged plant life, including tree stumps in their original growing positions, have been found, according to Sir Henry De la Beche, along the coasts of Devon, Cornwall, and Western Somerset. These findings not only suggest that there’s been a change in the relative levels of sea and land, since the animals and plants were the same as those currently living in this area; but, notably, there’s evidence that this submergence occurred, at least in part, after the area was inhabited by humans.436

A submarine forest occurring at the mouth of the Parret in Somersetshire, on the south side of the Bristol Channel, was described by Mr. L. Horner, in 1815, and its position attributed to subsidence. A bed of peat is there seen below the level of the sea, and the trunks of 324 large trees, such as the oak and yew, having their roots still diverging as they grew, and fixed in blue clay.437

A submerged forest at the mouth of the Parret in Somerset, on the south side of the Bristol Channel, was described by Mr. L. Horner in 1815, and it's believed to be due to land sinking. A layer of peat can be seen below sea level, along with the trunks of large trees like oak and yew, still having their roots spreading out as they used to, embedded in blue clay.324437

Tradition of loss of land in Cornwall.—The oldest historians mention a tradition in Cornwall, of the submersion of the Lionnesse, a country said to have stretched from the Land's End to the Scilly Islands. The tract, if it existed, must have been thirty miles in length, and perhaps ten in breadth. The land now remaining on either side is from two hundred to three hundred feet high; the intervening sea about three hundred feet deep. Although there is no authentic evidence for this romantic tale, it probably originated in some former inroads of the Atlantic, accompanying, perhaps, a subsidence of land on this coast.438

Tradition of loss of land in Cornwall.—The earliest historians talk about a tradition in Cornwall regarding the submersion of the Lionnesse, a region believed to have stretched from Land's End to the Scilly Islands. If this land existed, it would have been about thirty miles long and maybe ten miles wide. The land that remains on both sides is from two hundred to three hundred feet high, while the sea in between is about three hundred feet deep. Even though there's no solid proof for this romantic story, it likely came from past invasions of the Atlantic, possibly linked to a sinking of land along this coast.438

West coast of England.—Having now brought together an ample body of proofs of the destructive operations of the waves, tides, and currents, on our eastern and southern shores, it will be unnecessary to enter into details of changes on the western coast, for they present merely a repetition of the same phenomena, and in general on an inferior scale. On the borders of the estuary of the Severn the flats of Somersetshire and Gloucestershire have received enormous accessions, while, on the other hand, the coast of Cheshire, between the rivers Mersey and Dee, has lost, since the year 1764, many hundred yards, and some affirm more than half a mile, by the advance of the sea upon the abrupt cliffs of red clay and marls. Within the period above mentioned several lighthouses have been successively abandoned.439 There are traditions in Pembrokeshire440 and Cardiganshire441 of far greater losses of territory than that which the Lionnesse tale of Cornwall pretends to commemorate. They are all important, as demonstrating that the earliest inhabitants were familiar with the phenomenon of incursions of the sea.

West coast of England.—Having now gathered a significant amount of evidence about the damaging effects of waves, tides, and currents on our eastern and southern shores, there’s no need to go into detail about changes on the western coast, as they essentially mirror the same patterns, though generally on a smaller scale. Along the edges of the Severn estuary, the lowlands of Somersetshire and Gloucestershire have gained considerable land, while the coast of Cheshire, between the rivers Mersey and Dee, has lost hundreds of yards—some even claim more than half a mile—due to the sea encroaching on the steep red clay and marl cliffs since 1764. During this time, several lighthouses have been successively abandoned.439 There are stories in Pembrokeshire440 and Cardiganshire441 about even greater losses of land than those recounted in the Lionnesse tale of Cornwall. These are all significant because they show that the earliest inhabitants were aware of the phenomenon of the sea advancing.

Loss of land on the coast of France.—The French coast, particularly that part of Brittany, where the tides rise to an extraordinary height, is the constant prey of the waves. In the ninth century many villages and woods are reported to have been carried away, the coast undergoing great change, whereby the hill of St. Michael was detached from the mainland. The parish of Bourgneuf, and several others in that neighborhood, were overflowed in the year 1500. In 1735, during a great storm, the ruins of Palnel were seen uncovered in the sea.442

Loss of land on the coast of France.—The French coast, especially in Brittany, where the tides rise incredibly high, is constantly battered by the waves. In the ninth century, many villages and woodlands were reported to have been swept away, significantly altering the coastline, which led to St. Michael's hill becoming separated from the mainland. The parish of Bourgneuf and several others nearby were inundated in the year 1500. In 1735, during a massive storm, the ruins of Palnel were visible in the sea.442


CHAPTER XX.

ACTION OF TIDES AND CURRENTS—continued.

Inroads of the sea at the mouths of the Rhine in Holland—Changes in the arms of the Rhine—Proofs of subsidence of land—Estuary of the Bies Bosoh, formed in 1421—Zuyder Zee, in the 13th century—Islands destroyed—Delta of the Ems converted into a bay—Estuary of the Dollart formed—Encroachment of the sea on the coast of Sleswick—On shores of North America—Tidal wave, called the Bore—Influence of tides and currents on the mean level of seas—Action of currents in inland lakes and seas—Baltic—Cimbrian deluge—Straits of Gibraltar—No under-current there—Whether salt is precipitated in the Mediterranean—Waste of shores of Mediterranean.

Invasions of the sea at the mouths of the Rhine in Holland—Changes in the arms of the Rhine—Evidence of land sinking—Bies Bosoh estuary, formed in 1421—Zuyder Zee, in the 13th century—Islands lost—Ems delta turned into a bay—Dollart estuary created—Sea encroachment on the coast of Sleswick—On the shores of North America—Tidal wave known as the Bore—Effects of tides and currents on the average sea level—Influence of currents in inland lakes and seas—Baltic—Cimbrian flood—Straits of Gibraltar—No undercurrent there—Whether salt is deposited in the Mediterranean—Erosion of the Mediterranean shores.

Inroads of the sea at the mouths of the Rhine.—The line of British coast considered in the preceding chapter offered no example of the conflict of two great antagonist forces; the influx, on the one hand, of a river draining a large continent, and, on the other, the action of the waves, tides, and currents of the ocean. But when we pass over by the Straits of Dover to the Continent, and proceed northeastwards, we find an admirable illustration of such a contest, where the ocean and the Rhine are opposed to each other, each disputing the ground now occupied by Holland; the one striving to shape out an estuary, the other to form a delta. There was evidently a period when the river obtained the ascendancy, when the shape and perhaps the relative level of the coast and set of the tides were very different; but for the last two thousand years, during which man has witnessed and actively participated in the struggle, the result has been in favor of the ocean; the area of the whole territory having become more and more circumscribed; natural and artificial barriers having given away, one after another; and many hundred thousand human beings having perished in the waves.

Inroads of the sea at the mouths of the Rhine.—The section of the British coast discussed in the previous chapter didn’t showcase the clash of two powerful opposing forces; on one side, we have a river draining a vast continent, and on the other, the impact of ocean waves, tides, and currents. However, as we cross the Straits of Dover to the Continent and head northeast, we find a perfect example of this struggle, where the ocean and the Rhine are at odds, each competing for control of the land that is now Holland; one trying to carve out an estuary, the other aiming to create a delta. There was clearly a time when the river had the upper hand, when the shape and possibly the relative height of the coast and the direction of the tides were very different. But for the last two thousand years, during which humans have observed and actively engaged in this conflict, the outcome has favored the ocean; the entire area has become more and more restricted; natural and man-made barriers have crumbled, one after the other; and many hundreds of thousands of people have lost their lives to the waves.

Changes in the arms of the Rhine.—The Rhine, after flowing from the Grison Alps, copiously charged with sediment, first purifies itself in the Lake of Constance, where a large delta is formed; then swelled by the Aar and numerous other tributaries, it flows for more than six hundred miles towards the north; when, entering a low tract, it divides into two arms, about ten miles northeast of Cleves,—a point which must therefore be considered the head of its delta. (See *, map, fig. 38.) In speaking of the delta, I do not mean to assume that all that part of Holland which is comprised within the several arms of the Rhine can be called a delta in the strictest sense of the term; because some portion of the country thus circumscribed, as, for example, a part of Gelderland and Utrecht, consists of strata which may have been deposited in the sea before the Rhine existed. These older tracts may either have been raised like the Ullah Bund in Cutch, during the period when the 326 sediment of the Rhine was converting a part of the sea into land, or they may have constituted islands previously.

Changes in the arms of the Rhine.—The Rhine, after flowing from the Grison Alps, heavily loaded with sediment, first cleanses itself in Lake Constance, where a large delta forms; then, swollen by the Aar and many other tributaries, it flows for over six hundred miles northward; upon entering a low area, it splits into two branches about ten miles northeast of Cleves—making this point the head of its delta. (See *, map, fig. 38.) When I mention the delta, I don't mean to suggest that all of Holland within the several branches of the Rhine can strictly be called a delta, because some of the land within those borders, like parts of Gelderland and Utrecht, is made up of layers that may have been deposited in the sea before the Rhine came into being. These older areas might have been raised up like the Ullah Bund in Cutch, during the time when the Rhine’s sediment was turning part of the sea into land, or they could have been islands before.

Fig. 38.The dark tint between Antwerp and Nieuport

The dark tint between Antwerp and Nieuport, represents part of the Netherlands which was land in the time of the Romans, then overflowed by the sea before and during the 5th century, and afterwards reconverted into land.

The dark area between Antwerp and Nieuport represents a part of the Netherlands that was land during Roman times, then flooded by the sea before and during the 5th century, and later turned back into land.

When the river divides north of Cleves, the left arm takes the name of the Waal; and the right, retaining that of the Rhine, is connected, a little farther to the north, by an artificial canal with the river Yssel. The Rhine then flowing westward divides again southeast of Utrecht, and from this point it takes the name of the Leck, a name which was given to distinguish it from the northern arm called the old Rhine, which was sanded up until the year 1825, when a channel was cut for it, by which it now enters the sea at Catwyck. It is common, in all great deltas, that the principal channels of discharge should shift from time to time, but in Holland so many magnificent canals have been constructed, and have so diverted, from time to time, the course of the waters, that the geographical changes in this delta are endless, and their history, since the Roman era, forms a complicated topic of antiquarian research. The present head of the delta is about forty geographical miles from the nearest part of the gulf called the Zuyder Zee, and more than twice that distance from the general coast-line. The present head of the delta of the Nile is about 80 or 90 geographical miles from the sea; that of the Ganges, as before stated, 220; and that of the Mississippi about 180, reckoning from the point where the Atchafalaya branches off to the extremity of the new tongue of land in the Gulf of Mexico. But the comparative distance between the heads 327 of deltas and the sea affords no positive data for estimating the relative magnitude of the alluvial tracts formed by their respective rivers, for the ramifications depend on many varying and temporary circumstances, and the area over which they extend does not hold any constant proportion to the volume of water in the river.

When the river splits north of Cleves, the left branch is called the Waal, while the right side keeps the name Rhine and connects a bit further north via an artificial canal to the river Yssel. The Rhine then flows westward and splits again southeast of Utrecht, taking on the name Leck at this point to differentiate it from the northern branch known as the old Rhine. That branch became silted up until 1825 when a channel was created to allow its flow into the sea at Catwyck. It's common for the main channels in large deltas to shift over time, but in Holland, numerous beautiful canals have been built that frequently redirect the water's path, resulting in endless geographical changes in this delta. Its history since the Roman era is a complex subject for historians. The current head of the delta is about forty geographical miles from the closest part of the gulf called the Zuyder Zee, and more than twice that distance from the general coastline. The current head of the Nile delta is about 80 or 90 geographical miles from the sea; for the Ganges, as mentioned earlier, it's 220 miles; and for the Mississippi, about 180 miles, measured from where the Atchafalaya branches off to the end of the new landform in the Gulf of Mexico. However, the distance between the heads of deltas and the sea doesn't provide reliable data for measuring the relative size of the alluvial areas created by their rivers, as the branches depend on many changing and temporary factors, and the area they cover does not maintain a consistent relationship to the river's water volume.

The Rhine therefore has at present three mouths. About two-thirds of its waters flow to the sea by the Waal, and the remainder is carried partly to the Zuyder Zee by the Yssel, and partly to the ocean by the Leck. As the whole coast to the south as far as Ostend, and on the north to the entrance of the Baltic, has, with few exceptions, from time immemorial, yielded to the force of the waves, it is evident that the common delta of the Rhine, Meuse, and Scheldt, for these three rivers may all be considered as discharging their waters into the same part of the sea, would, if its advance had not been checked, have become extremely prominent; and even if it had remained stationary, would long ere this have projected far beyond the rounded outline of the coast, like that strip of land already described at the mouth of the Mississippi. But we find, on the contrary, that the islands which skirt the coast have not only lessened in size, but in number also, while great bays have been formed in the interior by incursions of the sea.

The Rhine currently has three outlets. About two-thirds of its water flows to the sea via the Waal, while the rest is split between reaching the Zuyder Zee through the Yssel and flowing to the ocean via the Leck. Since the entire coastline south to Ostend and north to the entrance of the Baltic has, with few exceptions, surrendered to the waves for ages, it's clear that the combined delta of the Rhine, Meuse, and Scheldt—since these three rivers all discharge into the same part of the sea—would have become quite prominent if its expansion hadn't been halted. Even if it had stayed in place, it would have extended well beyond the rounded shape of the coast long ago, much like the land at the mouth of the Mississippi. Instead, we see that the islands along the coast have not only shrunk in size but also in number, while large bays have formed inland due to the sea's encroachment.

In order to explain the incessant advance of the ocean on the shores and inland country of Holland, M. E. de Beaumont has suggested that there has in all probability been a general depression or sinking of the land below its former level over a wide area. Such a change of level would enable the sea to break through the ancient line of sand-banks and islands which protected the coast,—would lead to the enlargement of bays, the formation of new estuaries, and ultimately to the entire submergence of land. These views appear to be supported by the fact that several peat-mosses of fresh-water origin now occur under the level of the sea, especially on the site of the Zuyder Zee and Lake Flevo, presently to be mentioned. Several excavations also made for wells at Utrecht, Amsterdam, and Rotterdam have proved, that below the level of the ocean, the soil near the coast consists of alternations of sand with marine shells, and beds of peat and clay, which have been traced to the depth of fifty feet and upwards.443

To explain the constant encroachment of the ocean on the shores and inland areas of Holland, M. E. de Beaumont has suggested that there has likely been a widespread sinking of the land below its previous level. Such a change would allow the sea to breach the old line of sandbanks and islands that used to protect the coast, leading to larger bays, the creation of new estuaries, and eventually, the complete submersion of land. These ideas seem to be supported by the fact that several freshwater peat bogs are now found below sea level, particularly in the areas of the Zuyder Zee and Lake Flevo, which will be mentioned shortly. Additionally, several wells dug in Utrecht, Amsterdam, and Rotterdam have revealed that beneath the ocean level, the soil near the coast is made up of layers of sand mixed with marine shells, as well as beds of peat and clay, which have been traced to depths of fifty feet and more.443

I have said that the coast to the south as far as Ostend has given way. This statement may at first seem opposed to the fact, that the tract between Antwerp and Nieuport, shaded black in the annexed map (fig. 38), although now dry land, and supporting a large population, has, within the historical period, been covered with the sea. This region, however, consisted, in the time of the Romans, of woods, marshes, and peat-mosses, protected from the ocean by a chain of sandy dunes, which were afterwards broken through during storms, especially in the fifth century. The waters of the sea during these irruptions threw down upon the barren peat a horizontal bed of fertile 328 clay, which is in some places three yards thick, full of recent shells and works of art. The inhabitants, by the aid of embankments and the sand dunes of the coast, have succeeded, although not without frequent disasters, in defending the soil thus raised by the marine deposit.444

I’ve mentioned that the coastline to the south, all the way to Ostend, has receded. This may initially seem contradictory to the fact that the area between Antwerp and Nieuport, marked in black on the attached map (fig. 38) and now dry land supporting a large population, was once underwater during historical times. However, this region was made up of forests, swamps, and peat bogs during Roman times, shielded from the ocean by a series of sandy dunes. These dunes were eventually breached during storms, especially in the fifth century. During these events, the sea's waters deposited a layer of fertile clay on the barren peat, which in some places is three yards deep and filled with recent shells and artifacts. The residents, with the help of embankments and the coastal sand dunes, have managed, though not without frequent disasters, to protect the soil created by these marine deposits.444

Inroads of the Sea in Holland.—If we pass to the northward of the territory just alluded to, and cross the Scheldt, we find that between the fourteenth and eighteenth centuries parts of the islands Walcheren and Beveland were swept away, and several populous districts of Kadzand, losses which far more than counterbalance the gain of land caused by the sanding up of some pre-existing creeks. In 1658 the Island Orisant was annihilated. One of the most memorable inroads of the sea occurred in 1421, when the tide, pouring into the mouth of the united Meuse and Waal, burst through a dam in the district between Dort and Gertrudenberg, and overflowed seventy-two villages, forming a large sheet of water called the Bies Bosch. (See map, fig. 38.) Thirty-five of the villages were irretrievably lost, and no vestige, even of their ruins, was afterwards seen. The rest were redeemed, and the site of the others, though still very generally represented on maps as an estuary, has in fact been gradually filled up by alluvial deposits, and had become in 1835, as I was informed by Professor Moll, an immense plain, yielding abundant crops of hay, though still uninhabited. To the north of the Meuse is a long line of shore covered with sand dunes, where great encroachments have taken place from time to time, in consequence chiefly of the prevalence of southeasterly winds, which blow down the sands towards the sea. The church of Scheveningen, not far from the Hague, was once in the middle of the village, and now stands on the shore, half the place having been overwhelmed by the waves in 1570. Catwyck, once far from the sea, is now upon the shore; two of its streets having been overflowed, and land torn away to the extent of 200 yards, in 1719. It is only by the aid of embankments that Petten, and several other places farther north, have been defended against the sea.

Inroads of the Sea in Holland.—If we head north from the area just mentioned and cross the Scheldt, we find that between the fourteenth and eighteenth centuries, parts of the islands Walcheren and Beveland were washed away, along with several populated areas of Kadzand. These losses significantly outweighed the gains from the land formed by the silting of some existing creeks. In 1658, the Island Orisant was completely destroyed. One of the most notable incursions of the sea happened in 1421 when the tide surged into the combined mouths of the Meuse and Waal, broke through a dam between Dordrecht and Gertrudenberg, and flooded seventy-two villages, creating a large body of water known as the Bies Bosch. (See map, fig. 38.) Thirty-five of those villages were lost forever, with no trace of even their ruins remaining. The others were saved, and while the site of the lost villages is still often shown on maps as an estuary, it has gradually been filled in with sediment and by 1835, according to Professor Moll, had become a vast plain yielding rich hay crops, although it remained uninhabited. North of the Meuse is a long stretch of shoreline covered with sand dunes, which have periodically advanced due to the prevailing southeasterly winds that blow sand toward the sea. The church in Scheveningen, near The Hague, used to be in the center of the village but now sits on the shore, as half the village was washed away by waves in 1570. Catwyck, once far from the coastline, is now right on the shore, with two of its streets flooded and 200 yards of land eroded away in 1719. It is only thanks to embankments that Petten and several other places further north have been protected from the sea.

Formation of the Zuyder Zee and Straits of Staveren.—Still more important are the changes which have taken place on the coast opposite the right arm of the Rhine, or the Yssel, where the ocean has burst through a large isthmus, and entered the inland lake Flevo, which, in ancient times, was, according to Pomponius Mela, formed by the overflowing of the Rhine over certain lowlands. It appears that, in the time of Tacitus, there were several lakes on the present site of the Zuyder Zee, between Friesland and Holland. The successive inroads by which these and a great part of the adjoining territory, were transformed into a great gulf, began about the commencement, and were completed towards the close, of the thirteenth century. Alting gives the following relation of the occurrence, drawn from manuscript documents of contemporary inhabitants of the neighboring provinces. 329 In the year 1205, the island now called Wieringen, to the south of the Texel, was still a part of the mainland, but during several high floods, of which the dates are given, ending in December, 1251, it was separated from the continent. By subsequent incursions the sea consumed great parts of the rich and populous isthmus, a low tract which stretched on the north of Lake Flevo, between Staveren in Friesland and Medemblick in Holland, till at length a breach was completed about the year 1282, and afterwards widened. Great destruction of land took place when the sea first broke in, and many towns were swept away; but there was afterwards a reaction to a certain extent, large tracts, at first submerged, having been gradually redeemed. The new straits south of Staveren are more than half the width of those of Dover, but are very shallow, the greatest depth not exceeding two or three fathoms. The new bay is of a somewhat circular form, and between thirty and forty miles in diameter. How much of this space may formerly have been occupied by Lake Flevo is unknown. (See map, fig. 38.)

Formation of the Zuyder Zee and Straits of Staveren.—Even more significant are the changes that have occurred on the coast opposite the right branch of the Rhine, or the Yssel, where the ocean has broken through a large isthmus, entering the inland lake Flevo. According to Pomponius Mela, this lake was formed in ancient times by the Rhine flooding certain lowland areas. It seems that during Tacitus's time, there were several lakes at what is now the site of the Zuyder Zee, located between Friesland and Holland. The series of incursions that transformed these lakes and much of the surrounding area into a large gulf began around the start and were completed toward the end of the thirteenth century. Alting provides the following account, based on manuscript records from contemporary residents of nearby provinces. 329 In 1205, the island now known as Wieringen, south of Texel, was still part of the mainland. However, due to several significant floods, with specific dates leading up to December 1251, it became separated from the continent. Following further incursions, the sea consumed large portions of the rich and populous isthmus, a low area north of Lake Flevo, stretching between Staveren in Friesland and Medemblick in Holland. Eventually, a breach was completed around the year 1282 and later expanded. A significant amount of land was destroyed when the sea first broke in, sweeping away many towns; however, there was a certain degree of recovery afterward, as large areas that were initially submerged were gradually reclaimed. The new straits south of Staveren are more than half the width of those at Dover but are very shallow, with a maximum depth of only two or three fathoms. The new bay is somewhat circular and between thirty and forty miles in diameter. It remains unclear how much of this space was previously occupied by Lake Flevo. (See map, fig. 38.)

Destruction of islands.—A series of islands stretching from the Texel to the mouths of the Weser and Elbe are probably the last relics of a tract once continuous. They have greatly diminished in size, and have lost about a third of their number, since the time of Pliny; for that naturalist counted twenty-three islands between the Texel and Eider, whereas there are now only sixteen, including Heligoland and Neuwerk.445 The island of Heligoland, at the mouth of the Elbe, consists of a rock of red marl of the Keuper formation (of the Germans), and is bounded by perpendicular red cliffs, above 200 feet high. Although, according to some accounts, it has been greatly reduced in size since the year 800, M. Wiebel assures us, that the ancient map by Meyer cannot be depended upon, and that the island, according to the description still extant by Adam of Bremen, was not much larger than now, in the time of Charlemagne. On comparing the map made in the year 1793 by the Danish engineer Wessel, the average encroachment of the sea on the cliffs, between that period and the year 1848 (or about half a century), did not amount to more than three feet.446 On the other hand, some few islands have extended their bounds in one direction, or become connected with others, by the sanding-up of channels; but even these, like Juist, have generally given way as much on the north towards the sea as they have gained on the south, or land side.

Destruction of islands.—A series of islands stretching from Texel to the mouths of the Weser and Elbe are likely the last remnants of what was once a continuous landmass. They have significantly decreased in size, losing about a third of their original number since Pliny’s time; he counted twenty-three islands between Texel and Eider, while there are now only sixteen, including Heligoland and Neuwerk.445 Heligoland, located at the mouth of the Elbe, consists of a red marl rock from the Keuper formation (of the Germans) and is surrounded by steep red cliffs that rise over 200 feet high. Although some sources suggest it has shrunk significantly since 800 AD, M. Wiebel assures us that the old map by Meyer isn’t reliable and that, based on Adam of Bremen’s still-existing description, the island wasn’t much larger during Charlemagne’s time. Comparing the map created in 1793 by Danish engineer Wessel, the average erosion of the cliffs caused by the sea from that time until 1848 (about fifty years) was no more than three feet.446 On the other hand, a few islands have expanded in some areas or become connected to others due to channels filling with sand; however, even these, like Juist, have generally lost as much land to the sea on the north side as they have gained on the southern or land side.

The Dollart formed.—While the delta of the Rhine has suffered so materially from the movements of the ocean, it can hardly be supposed that minor rivers on the same coast should have been permitted to extend their deltas. It appears that in the time of the Romans there was an alluvial plain of great fertility, where the Ems entered the sea 330 by three arms. This low country stretched between Groningen and Friesland, and sent out a peninsula to the northeast towards Emden. A flood in 1277 first destroyed part of the peninsula. Other inundations followed at different periods throughout the fifteenth century. In 1507, a part only of Torum, a considerable town, remained standing; and in spite of the erection of dams, the remainder of that place, together with market-towns, villages, and monasteries, to the number of fifty, were finally overwhelmed. The new gulf, which was called the Dollart, although small in comparison to the Zuyder Zee, occupied no less than six square miles at first; but part of this space was, in the course of the two following centuries, again redeemed from the sea. The small bay of Leybucht, farther north, was formed in a similar manner in the thirteenth century; and the bay of Harlbucht in the middle of the sixteenth. Both of these have since been partially reconverted into dry land. Another new estuary, called the Gulf of Jahde, near the mouth of the Weser, scarcely inferior in size to the Dollart, has been gradually hollowed out since the year 1016, between which era and 1651 a space of about four square miles has been added to the sea. The rivulet which now enters this inlet is very small; but Arens conjectures that an arm of the Weser had once an outlet in that direction.

The Dollart formed.—While the delta of the Rhine has been greatly affected by ocean movements, it's unlikely that smaller rivers along the same coast would have been allowed to expand their deltas. It seems that during Roman times there was a highly fertile alluvial plain where the Ems river met the sea 330 through three channels. This low-lying area lay between Groningen and Friesland and extended as a peninsula to the northeast toward Emden. A flood in 1277 first wiped out part of the peninsula. Other floods occurred at various times in the fifteenth century. By 1507, only part of Torum, a significant town, remained; despite building dams, the rest of the town, along with market towns, villages, and monasteries—about fifty in total—were ultimately submerged. The new gulf, known as the Dollart, though small compared to the Zuyder Zee, initially covered around six square miles, but some of that area was reclaimed from the sea over the next two centuries. The small bay of Leybucht, further north, was similarly created in the thirteenth century, and the bay of Harlbucht emerged in the mid-sixteenth century. Both of these have since been partially restored to dry land. Another new estuary, called the Gulf of Jahde, located near the mouth of the Weser and almost as large as the Dollart, has been gradually carved out since the year 1016, adding approximately four square miles to the sea by 1651. The stream currently flowing into this inlet is quite small, but Arens speculates that a branch of the Weser once had an outlet in that direction.

Coast of Sleswick.—Farther north we find so many records of waste on the western coast of Sleswick, as to lead us to anticipate that, at no distant period in the history of the physical geography of Europe, Jutland may become an island, and the ocean may obtain a more direct entrance into the Baltic. Indeed, the temporary insulation of the northern extremity of Jutland has been affected no less than four times within the records of history, the ocean having as often made a breach through the bar of sand, which usually excludes it from the Lym Fiord. This long frith is 120 miles in length including its windings, and communicates at its eastern end with the Baltic. The last irruption of salt water happened in 1824, and the fiord was still open in 1837, when some vessels of thirty tons' burden passed through.

Coast of Sleswick.—Further north, we find so many records of erosion on the western coast of Sleswick that it makes us think that, at some point in the near future, Jutland could become an island, allowing the ocean to have a more direct route into the Baltic Sea. In fact, the temporary isolation of the northern tip of Jutland has occurred no less than four times in recorded history, with the ocean breaking through the sandbar that typically keeps it from the Lym Fiord. This long inlet is 120 miles long, including its twists and turns, and connects to the Baltic at its eastern end. The last time saltwater flooded in was in 1824, and the fiord was still open in 1837, when some thirty-ton vessels passed through.

The Marsh islands between the rivers Elbe and Eider are mere banks, like the lands formed of the "warp" in the Humber, protected by dikes. Some of them, after having been inhabited with security for more than ten centuries, have been suddenly overwhelmed. In this manner, in 1216, no less than ten thousand of the inhabitants of Eiderstede and Ditmarsch perished; and on the 11th of October, 1634, the islands and the whole coast, as far as Jutland, suffered by a dreadful deluge.

The Marsh islands between the Elbe and Eider rivers are just banks, similar to the lands created by the "warp" in the Humber, which are protected by dikes. Some of these islands, after being safely inhabited for over a thousand years, were suddenly flooded. For example, in 1216, around ten thousand people from Eiderstede and Ditmarsch lost their lives; and on October 11, 1634, the islands and the entire coast, all the way to Jutland, experienced a terrible flood.

Destruction of Northstrand by the sea.—Northstrand, up to the year 1240, was, with the islands Sylt and Föhr, so nearly connected with the mainland as to appear a peninsula, and was called North Friesland, a highly cultivated and populous district. It measured from nine to eleven geographical miles from north to south, and six to eight from east to west. In the above-mentioned year it was torn asunder from the continent, and in part overwhelmed. The Isle of Northstrand, 331 thus formed, was, towards the end of the sixteenth century, only four geographical miles in circumference, and was still celebrated for its cultivation and numerous population. After many losses, it still contained nine thousand inhabitants. At last, in the year 1634, on the evening of the 11th of October, a flood passed over the whole island, whereby 1300 houses, with many churches, were lost; fifty thousand head of cattle perished, and above six thousand men. Three small islets, one of them still called Northstrand, alone remained, which are now continually wasting.

Destruction of Northstrand by the sea.—Up until 1240, Northstrand, along with the islands of Sylt and Föhr, was so closely connected to the mainland that it seemed like a peninsula, and was known as North Friesland, a highly developed and populated area. It stretched from nine to eleven geographical miles from north to south, and six to eight from east to west. In that year, it was separated from the continent and partly submerged. The Isle of Northstrand, 331 that was formed, measured only four geographical miles around by the end of the sixteenth century and was still known for its agriculture and large population. Despite significant losses, it still had nine thousand residents. Finally, on the evening of October 11, 1634, a flood swept over the entire island, destroying 1300 houses, including many churches; fifty thousand livestock were lost, along with over six thousand people. Only three small islands remained, one of which is still called Northstrand, and they are continually eroding away.

The redundancy of river water in the Baltic, especially during the melting of ice and snow in spring, causes in general an outward current through the channel called the Cattegat. But after a continuance of northwesterly gales, especially during the height of the spring-tides, the Atlantic rises, and pouring a flood of water into the Baltic, commits dreadful devastations on the isles of the Danish Archipelago. This current even acts, though with diminished force, as far eastward as the vicinity of Dantzic.447 Accounts written during the last ten centuries attest the wearing down of promontories on the Danish coast, the deepening of gulfs, the severing of peninsulas from the mainland, and the waste of islands, while in several cases marsh land, defended for centuries by dikes, has at last been overflowed, and thousands of the inhabitants whelmed in the waves. Thus the island Barsoe, on the coast of Sleswick, has lost, year after year, an acre at a time, and the island Alsen suffers in like manner.

The excess river water in the Baltic, especially during the spring thaw, generally creates an outward flow through the channel known as the Cattegat. However, after prolonged northwesterly storms, particularly during high spring tides, the Atlantic rises and floods the Baltic, causing severe damage to the islands of the Danish Archipelago. This current even reaches, albeit with reduced strength, as far east as the area near Danzig.447 Records from the past ten centuries show the degradation of cliffs along the Danish coast, the deepening of bays, the separation of peninsulas from the mainland, and the erosion of islands, while in several cases, marshland that had been protected by dikes for centuries has finally been inundated, drowning thousands of residents. For example, the island of Barsoe, off the coast of Sleswick, has lost an acre each year, and the island of Alsen is facing similar losses.

Cimbrian deluge.—As we have already seen that during the flood before mentioned, 6000 men and 50,000 head of cattle perished on Northstrand on the western coast of Jutland, we are all well prepared to find that this peninsula, the Cimbrica Chersonesus of the ancients, has from a remote period been the theatre of like catastrophes. Accordingly, Strabo records a story, although he treats it as an incredible fiction, that, during a high tide, the ocean rose upon this coast so rapidly, that men on horseback were scarcely able to escape.448 Florus, alluding to the same tradition, says, "Cimbri, Teutoni, atque Tigurini, ab extremis Galliæ profugi, cùm terras eorum inundasset Oceanus, novas sedes toto orbe quærebant."449 This event, commonly called the "Cimbrian Deluge," is supposed to have happened about three centuries before the Christian era; but it is not improbable that the principal catastrophe was preceded and followed by many devastations like those experienced in modern times on the islands and shores of Jutland, and such calamities may well be conceived to have forced on the migration of some maritime tribes.

Cimbrian deluge.—As we've already noted, during the aforementioned flood, 6,000 people and 50,000 cattle lost their lives on Northstrand, along the western coast of Jutland. It's clear that this peninsula, known as the Cimbrica Chersonesus to the ancients, has been the site of similar disasters for a long time. Strabo recounts a story, which he considers unbelievable, that during a high tide, the ocean surged onto this coast so quickly that men on horseback could hardly escape.448 Florus, referencing the same legend, states, "Cimbri, Teutoni, and Tigurini, fleeing from the farthest reaches of Gaul, sought new homes around the world when the ocean flooded their lands."449 This event, commonly known as the "Cimbrian Deluge," is believed to have occurred about three centuries before the Common Era. However, it's likely that the main disaster was preceded and followed by similar devastation, like what we've seen in modern times on the islands and coasts of Jutland, which could have driven some coastal tribes to migrate.

Inroads of the sea on the eastern shores of North America.—After so many authentic details respecting the destruction of the coast in parts of Europe best known, it will be unnecessary to multiply examples of 332 analogous changes in more distant regions of the world. It must not, however, be imagined that our own seas form any exception to the general rule. Thus, for example, if we pass over to the eastern coast of North America, where the tides rise, in the Bay of Fundy, to a great elevation, we find many facts attesting the incessant demolition of land. Cliffs, often several hundred feet high, composed of sandstone, red marl, and other rocks, which border that bay and its numerous estuaries, are perpetually undermined. The ruins of these cliffs are gradually carried, in the form of mud, sand, and large boulders, into the Atlantic by powerful currents, aided at certain seasons by drift ice, which forms along the coast, and freezes round large stones.

Inroads of the sea on the eastern shores of North America.—After so many reliable details about the destruction of coasts in the best-known parts of Europe, it’s unnecessary to provide more examples of similar changes in more distant areas of the world. However, it shouldn't be assumed that our own seas are any exception to this general trend. For example, if we look at the eastern coast of North America, where the tides rise dramatically in the Bay of Fundy, we find many facts showing the continuous erosion of land. Cliffs that are often several hundred feet high, made of sandstone, red marl, and other rocks, line that bay and its many estuaries and are constantly being undermined. The debris from these cliffs is slowly washed away as mud, sand, and large boulders into the Atlantic by strong currents, sometimes assisted by drifting ice that forms along the coast and freezes around large stones.

At Cape May, on the north side of Delaware Bay, in the United States, the encroachment of the sea was shown by observations made consecutively for sixteen years, from 1804 to 1820, to average about nine feet a year;450 and at Sullivan's Island, which lies on the north side of the entrance of the harbor of Charleston, in South Carolina, the sea carried away a quarter of a mile of land in three years, ending in 1786.451

At Cape May, on the north side of Delaware Bay in the United States, observations made over sixteen consecutive years, from 1804 to 1820, showed that the sea was encroaching at an average rate of about nine feet per year;450 and at Sullivan's Island, located on the north side of the entrance to the harbor of Charleston in South Carolina, the sea eroded a quarter of a mile of land in just three years, ending in 1786.451

Tidal wave called "the Bore."—Before concluding my remarks on the action of the tides, I must not omit to mention the wave called "the Bore," which is sometimes produced in a river where a large body of water is made to rise suddenly, in consequence of the contraction of the channel. This wave terminates abruptly on the inland side; because the quantity of water contained in it is so great, and its motion so rapid, that time is not allowed for the surface of the river to be immediately raised by means of transmitted pressure. A tide wave thus rendered abrupt has a close analogy, observes Mr. Whewell, to the waves which curl over and break on a shelving shore.452

Tidal wave called "the Bore."—Before I finish my thoughts on how tides work, I need to mention the wave known as "the Bore," which sometimes occurs in a river when a large volume of water suddenly rises due to the narrowing of the channel. This wave ends sharply on the inland side because the amount of water it holds is so large and its movement so fast that there's not enough time for the river's surface to immediately rise from the transmitted pressure. A tide wave that behaves this way is quite similar, as Mr. Whewell notes, to the waves that curl and break on a sloping shore.452

The Bore which enters the Severn, where the phenomenon is of almost daily occurrence, is sometimes nine feet high, and at spring-tides rushes up the estuary with extraordinary rapidity. The finest example which I have seen of this wave was at Nova Scotia,453 where the tide is said to rise in some places seventy feet perpendicular, and to be the highest in the world. In the large estuary of the Shubenacadie, which connects with another estuary called the Basin of Mines, itself an embranchment of the Bay of Fundy, a vast body of water comes rushing up, with a roaring noise, into a long narrow channel, and while it is ascending, has all the appearance of pouring down a slope as steep as that of the celebrated rapids of the St. Lawrence. In picturesque effect, however, it bears no comparison, for instead of the transparent green water and snow-white foam of the St. Lawrence, the whole current of the Shubenacadie is turbid and densely charged with red mud. The same phenomenon is frequently witnessed in the principal branches of the Ganges and in the Megna as before mentioned (p. 279). "In 333 the Hoogly," says Rennell, "the Bore commences at Hoogly Point, the place where the river first contracts itself, and is perceptible above Hoogly Town; and so quick is its motion, that it hardly employs four hours in travelling from one to the other, though the distance is nearly seventy miles. At Calcutta it sometimes occasions an instantaneous rise of five feet; and both here, and in every other part of its track, the boats, on its approach, immediately quit the shore, and make for safety to the middle of the river. In the channels, between the islands in the mouth of the Megna, the height of the Bore is said to exceed twelve feet; and is so terrific in its appearance, and dangerous in its consequences, that no boat will venture to pass at spring-tide."454 These waves may sometimes cause inundations, undermine cliffs, and still more frequently sweep away trees and land animals from low shores, so that they may be carried down, and ultimately imbedded in fluviatile or submarine deposits.

The Bore that flows into the Severn, where this phenomenon happens almost daily, can reach heights of nine feet and rushes up the estuary rapidly during spring tides. The best example I've seen of this wave was in Nova Scotia,453 where the tide is reported to rise as much as seventy feet in certain areas, making it the highest in the world. In the large estuary of the Shubenacadie, which connects with another estuary known as the Basin of Mines, an extension of the Bay of Fundy, a massive volume of water rushes in with a booming noise into a long, narrow channel, and while it climbs, it looks like it's flowing down a slope as steep as the famous rapids of the St. Lawrence. However, in terms of visual impact, it doesn't compare because instead of the clear green waters and bright white foam of the St. Lawrence, the whole current of the Shubenacadie is murky and thick with red mud. This same phenomenon is often seen in the main branches of the Ganges and in the Meghna, as mentioned earlier (p. 279). "In the Hoogly," Rennell states, "the Bore starts at Hoogly Point, where the river begins to narrow, and it can be seen above Hoogly Town; its motion is so swift that it takes less than four hours to travel nearly seventy miles from one point to the other. In Calcutta, it can sometimes cause an immediate rise of five feet; and in this area, as well as throughout its journey, boats flee the shore to seek safety in the middle of the river as it approaches. In the channels between the islands at the mouth of the Meghna, the height of the Bore can exceed twelve feet and is so frightening and hazardous that no boat dares to cross during spring tide."454 These waves can sometimes lead to flooding, erode cliffs, and more frequently wash away trees and land animals from low-lying areas, carrying them off to be eventually buried in river or seabed deposits.

CURRENTS IN INLAND LAKES AND SEAS.

In such large bodies of water as the North American lakes, the continuance of a strong wind in one direction often causes the elevation of the water, and its accumulation on the leeward side; and while the equilibrium is restoring itself, powerful currents are occasioned. In October, 1833, a strong current in Lake Erie, caused partly by the set of the waters towards the outlet of the lake, and partly by the prevailing wind, burst a passage through the extensive peninsula called Long Point, and soon excavated a channel more than nine feet deep and nine hundred feet wide. Its width and depth have since increased, and a new and costly pier has been erected; for it is hoped that this event will permanently improve the navigation of Lake Erie for steamboats.455 On the opposite, or southern coast of this lake, in front of the town of Cleveland, the degradation of the cliffs had been so rapid for several years preceding a survey made in 1837, as to threaten many towns with demolition.456 In the Black Sea, also, although free from tides, we learn from Pallas that there is a sufficiently strong current to undermine the cliffs in many parts, and particularly in the Crimea.

In big bodies of water like the North American lakes, a consistent strong wind blowing in one direction often causes the water level to rise and collect on the sheltered side. While the water is trying to balance out again, it creates powerful currents. In October 1833, a strong current in Lake Erie, caused partly by the water flowing toward the lake's outlet and partly by the strong wind, broke through the long peninsula known as Long Point, quickly digging out a channel more than nine feet deep and nine hundred feet wide. Since then, its width and depth have increased, and a new and expensive pier has been built; it's hoped that this will permanently improve navigation in Lake Erie for steamboats.455 On the opposite, or southern coastline of the lake, in front of Cleveland, the erosion of the cliffs had been so rapid for several years before a survey conducted in 1837 that it threatened to destroy many towns.456 In the Black Sea, although there are no tides, we learn from Pallas that there is a strong enough current to erode the cliffs in many areas, especially in Crimea.

Straits of Gibraltar.—It is well known that a powerful current sets constantly from the Atlantic into the Mediterranean, and its influence extends along the whole southern borders of that sea, and even to the shores of Asia Minor. Captain Smyth found, during his survey, that the central current ran constantly at the rate of from three to six miles an hour eastward into the Mediterranean, the body of water being three miles and a half wide. But there are also two lateral currents—one on the European, and one on the African side; each of them about two miles and a half broad, and flowing at about the same rate as the central stream. These lateral currents ebb and flow with the tide, setting alternately 334 into the Mediterranean and into the Atlantic. The excess of water constantly flowing in is very great, and there is only one cause to which this can be attributed, the loss of water in the Mediterranean by evaporation. That the level of this sea should be considerably depressed by this cause is quite conceivable, since we know that the winds blowing from the shores of Africa are hot and dry; and hygrometrical experiments recently made in Malta and other places, show that the mean quantity of moisture in the air investing the Mediterranean is equal only to one half of that in the atmosphere of England. The temperature also of the great inland sea is upon an average higher, by 3½° of Fahrenheit, than the eastern part of the Atlantic Ocean in the same latitude, which must greatly promote its evaporation. The Black Sea being situated in a higher latitude, and being the receptacle of rivers flowing from the north, is much colder, and its expenditure far less; accordingly it does not draw any supply from the Mediterranean, but, on the contrary, contributes to it by a current flowing outwards, for the most part of the year, through the Dardanelles. The discharge, however, at the Bosphorus is so small, when compared to the volume of water carried in by rivers, as to imply a great amount of evaporation in the Black Sea.

Straits of Gibraltar. — It’s well known that a strong current constantly flows from the Atlantic into the Mediterranean, affecting the entire southern coastline of that sea, even reaching the shores of Asia Minor. Captain Smyth discovered during his survey that the central current consistently moves eastward into the Mediterranean at a speed of three to six miles per hour, with the water body being three and a half miles wide. There are also two side currents—one on the European side and one on the African side; each is about two and a half miles wide and flows at a similar speed to the central current. These side currents ebb and flow with the tide, alternating between flowing into the Mediterranean and the Atlantic. The surplus of water consistently flowing in is significant and can only be attributed to one cause: the loss of water in the Mediterranean through evaporation. It is quite plausible that this sea's level would be considerably lowered for this reason, given that the winds blowing from the African shores are hot and dry; hygrometrical experiments recently conducted in Malta and other locations show that the average moisture content in the air surrounding the Mediterranean is only about half of that found in the atmosphere of England. The temperature of this large inland sea is also, on average, 3.5°F higher than that of the eastern part of the Atlantic Ocean at the same latitude, which significantly increases evaporation rates. The Black Sea, being located at a higher latitude and receiving rivers flowing from the north, is much colder, and thus its losses are much smaller; consequently, it doesn't supply water to the Mediterranean but rather contributes to it with a current flowing outward for most of the year through the Dardanelles. However, the outflow at the Bosporus is so minimal compared to the volume of water brought in by rivers that it suggests a significant amount of evaporation occurring in the Black Sea.

Whether salt be precipitated in the Mediterranean.—It is, however, objected, that evaporation carries away only fresh water, and that the current from the Atlantic is continually bringing in salt water: why, then, do not the component parts of the waters of the Mediterranean vary? or how can they remain so nearly the same as those of the ocean? Some have imagined that the excess of salt might be carried away by an under-current running in a contrary direction to the superior; and this hypothesis appeared to receive confirmation from a late discovery, that the water taken up about fifty miles within the Straits, from a depth of 670 fathoms, contained a quantity of salt four times greater than the water of the surface. Dr. Wollaston,457 who analyzed this water obtained by Captain Smyth, truly inferred that an under-current of such denser water flowing outward, if of equal breadth and depth with the current near the surface, would carry out as much salt below as is brought in above, although it moved with less than one-fourth part of the velocity, and would thus prevent a perpetual increase of saltness in the Mediterranean beyond that existing in the Atlantic. It was also remarked by others, that the result would be the same, if the swiftness being equal, the inferior current had only one-fourth of the volume of the superior. At the same time there appeared reason to conclude that this great specific gravity was only acquired by water at immense depths; for two specimens of the water, taken within the Mediterranean, at the distance of some hundred miles from the Straits, and at depths of 400 and even 450 fathoms, were found by Dr. Wollaston not to exceed in density that of many ordinary samples of sea-water. Such being the case, we can now prove that the vast amount of salt brought into the 335 Mediterranean does not pass out again by the Straits; for it appears by Captain Smyth's soundings, which Dr. Wallaston had not seen, that between the capes of Trafalgar and Spartel, which are twenty-two miles apart, and where the Straits are shallowest, the deepest part, which is on the side of Cape Spartel, is only 220 fathoms. It is therefore evident, that if water sinks in certain parts of the Mediterranean, in consequence of the increase of its specific gravity, to greater depths than 220 fathoms, it can never flow out again into the Atlantic, since it must be stopped by the submarine barrier which crosses the shallowest part of the Straits of Gibraltar.

Whether salt is found in the Mediterranean.—It is argued, however, that evaporation only removes fresh water and that the current from the Atlantic constantly brings in salt water: so why don’t the components of the Mediterranean waters change? Or how do they stay so similar to those of the ocean? Some people think that the extra salt might be carried away by an undercurrent flowing in the opposite direction to the surface current; this theory seemed to gain support from a recent finding showing that water taken about fifty miles into the Straits from a depth of 670 fathoms had a salt content four times greater than the surface water. Dr. Wollaston,457 who analyzed this water collected by Captain Smyth, deduced that an undercurrent of this denser water flowing out, if it had the same width and depth as the current above, would carry out as much salt below as is brought in above, even though it moved at less than a quarter of the speed, thus preventing a continuous increase of salinity in the Mediterranean beyond that of the Atlantic. Others noted that the outcome would be the same if the speeds were equal but the deeper current had only a quarter of the volume of the upper current. At the same time, there were reasons to believe that this high density was only reached by water at extreme depths; for two samples of water taken within the Mediterranean, several hundred miles from the Straits at depths of 400 and even 450 fathoms, were found by Dr. Wollaston not to be denser than many ordinary samples of seawater. Given this, we can now show that the large amount of salt entering the 335 Mediterranean does not exit again through the Straits; as shown by Captain Smyth's soundings, which Dr. Wollaston had not seen, that between the capes of Trafalgar and Spartel, which are twenty-two miles apart and where the Straits are shallowest, the deepest part, near Cape Spartel, is only 220 fathoms. It is therefore clear that if water sinks in certain areas of the Mediterranean due to its increased density to depths greater than 220 fathoms, it can never flow back out to the Atlantic, as it must be stopped by the underwater barrier that crosses the shallowest part of the Straits of Gibraltar.

The idea of the existence of a counter-current, at a certain depth, first originated in the following circumstances:—M. De l'Aigle, commander of a privateer called the Phœnix of Marseilles, gave chase to a Dutch merchant-ship, near Ceuta Point, and coming up with her in the middle of the gut, between Tariffa and Tangier, gave her one broadside, which directly sunk her. A few days after, the sunken ship, with her cargo of brandy and oil, was cast ashore near Tangier, which is at least four leagues to the westward of the place where she went down, and to which she must have floated in a direction contrary to the course of the central current.458 This fact, however, affords no evidence of an under-current, because the ship, when it approached the coast, would necessarily be within the influence of a lateral current, which running westward twice every twenty-four hours, might have brought back the vessel to Tangier.

The concept of a counter-current at a certain depth first came about under these circumstances: M. De l'Aigle, the captain of a privateer named the Phœnix from Marseilles, chased down a Dutch merchant ship near Ceuta Point. When he caught up with her in the channel between Tarifa and Tangier, he fired a broadside that sank her immediately. A few days later, the sunken ship, along with its cargo of brandy and oil, washed ashore near Tangier, which is at least four leagues to the west of where it sank, indicating it must have drifted against the current. However, this fact doesn’t prove the existence of an under-current, because as the ship neared the coast, it would have been under the influence of a lateral current that runs westward twice every twenty-four hours, which could have returned the vessel to Tangier.

What, then, becomes of the excess of salt?—for this is an inquiry of the highest geological interest. The Rhone, the Po, the Nile, and many hundred minor streams and springs, pour annually into the Mediterranean large quantities of carbonate of lime, together with iron, magnesia, silica, alumina, sulphur, and other mineral ingredients in a state of chemical solution. To explain why the influx of this matter does not alter the composition of this sea has never been regarded as a difficulty; for it is known that calcareous rocks are forming in the delta of the Rhone, in the Adriatic, on the coast of Asia Minor, and in other localities. Precipitation is acknowledged to be the means whereby the surplus mineral matter is disposed of, after the consumption of a certain portion in the secretions of testacea, zoophytes, and other marine animals. But before muriate of soda can, in like manner, be precipitated, the whole Mediterranean ought, according to the received principles of chemistry, to become as much saturated with salt as Lake Aral, the Dead Sea, or the brine-springs of Cheshire.

What happens to the excess salt then?—this is a question of great geological importance. The Rhone, the Po, the Nile, and many smaller streams and springs dump large amounts of lime carbonate, along with iron, magnesia, silica, alumina, sulfur, and other minerals in a dissolved form into the Mediterranean each year. It has never been considered a problem to explain why this influx of materials doesn't change the composition of the sea; it is known that calcareous rocks are forming in the delta of the Rhone, in the Adriatic, along the coast of Asia Minor, and in other areas. It's accepted that precipitation is the way the excess mineral matter is dealt with after a portion is used by the secretions of shellfish, coral, and other marine animals. However, before sodium chloride can be removed in the same way, the entire Mediterranean would, according to established chemistry principles, need to become as saturated with salt as the Aral Sea, the Dead Sea, or the brine springs in Cheshire.

It is undoubtedly true, in regard to small bodies of water, that every particle must be fully saturated with muriate of soda before a single crystal of salt can be formed; such is probably the case in all natural salterns: such, for example, as those described by travellers as occurring on the western borders of the Black Sea, where extensive marshes 336 are said to be covered by thin films of salt after a rapid evaporation of sea-water. The salt étangs of the Rhone, where salt has sometimes been precipitated in considerable abundance, have been already mentioned. In regard to the depth of the Mediterranean, it appears that between Gibraltar and Ceuta, Captain Smyth sounded to the enormous depth of 950 fathoms, and found there a gravelly bottom, with fragments of broken shells. Saussure sounded to the depth of two thousand feet, within a few yards of the shore, at Nice; and M. Bérard has lately fathomed to the depth of more than six thousand feet in several places without reaching the bottom.459

It is definitely true that in small bodies of water, every particle needs to be completely saturated with salt before a single crystal can form; this is likely the case in all natural salt flats, like those travelers describe along the western shores of the Black Sea, where large marshes are said to be covered by thin layers of salt after sea water has quickly evaporated. The salt ponds of the Rhone, where salt has occasionally been found in significant amounts, have already been mentioned. Regarding the depth of the Mediterranean, it seems that between Gibraltar and Ceuta, Captain Smyth measured an incredible depth of 950 fathoms and found a rocky bottom with fragments of broken shells. Saussure measured to a depth of two thousand feet just a short distance from the shore at Nice, and M. Bérard recently explored depths of over six thousand feet in several locations without reaching the bottom.459

The central abysses, therefore, of this sea are, in all likelihood, at least as deep as the Alps are high; and, as at the depth of seven hundred fathoms only, water has been found to contain a proportion of salt four times greater than at the surface, we may presume that the excess of salt may be much greater at the depth of two or three miles. After evaporation, the surface water becomes impregnated with a slight excess of salt, and its specific gravity being thus increased, it instantly falls to the bottom, while lighter water rises to the top, or flows in laterally, being always supplied by rivers and the current from the Atlantic. The heavier fluid, when it arrives at the bottom, cannot stop if it can gain access to any lower part of the bed of the sea, not previously occupied by water of the same density.

The central depths of this sea are probably at least as deep as the Alps are tall. At a depth of seven hundred fathoms, water has been found to have salt levels four times higher than at the surface, so we can guess that the salt content is much higher at depths of two or three miles. After evaporation, the surface water absorbs some extra salt, which increases its density, causing it to sink immediately while lighter water rises to the top or flows in from the sides, always fed by rivers and currents from the Atlantic. The heavier water, when it reaches the bottom, can't stay there if it can flow into any lower area of the seabed that isn't already filled with water of the same density.

How far this accumulation of brine can extend before the inferior strata of water will part with any of their salt, and what difference in such a chemical process the immense pressure of the incumbent ocean, or the escape of heated vapors, thermal springs, or submarine volcanic eruptions, might occasion, are questions which cannot be answered in the present state of science.

How far this buildup of saltwater can go before the lower layers of water release any of their salt, and what impact factors like the immense pressure of the overlying ocean, or the release of hot vapors, thermal springs, or underwater volcanic eruptions might have on this chemical process, are questions that science can't answer at this point.

The Straits of Gibraltar are said to become gradually wider by the wearing down of the cliffs on each side at many points; and the current sets along the coast of Africa, so as to cause considerable inroads in various parts, particularly near Carthage. Near the Canopic mouth of the Nile, at Aboukir, the coast was greatly devastated in the year 1784, when a small island was nearly consumed. By a series of similar operations, the old site of the cities of Nicropolis, Taposiris, Parva and Canopus, have become a sand-bank.460

The Straits of Gibraltar are said to be slowly getting wider as the cliffs on either side wear away at several points; and the current flows along the coast of Africa, causing significant erosion in various areas, especially near Carthage. Near the Canopic mouth of the Nile, at Aboukir, the coastline was heavily damaged in 1784, when a small island was almost erased. Through a series of similar processes, the original locations of the cities of Nicropolis, Taposiris, Parva, and Canopus have turned into a sandbank.460


CHAPTER XXI.

REPRODUCTIVE EFFECTS OF TIDES AND CURRENTS.

Estuaries, how formed—Silting up of estuaries does not compensate the loss of land on the borders of the ocean—Bed of the German Ocean—Composition and extent of its sand-banks—Strata deposited by currents in the English channel—On the shores of the Mediterranean—At the mouths of the Amazon, Orinoco, and Mississippi—Wide area over which strata may be formed by this cause.

Estuaries, how they’re formed—The buildup of silt in estuaries doesn’t make up for the loss of land along the ocean's edge—The bed of the North Sea—Makeup and size of its sandbanks—Layers deposited by currents in the English Channel—Along the Mediterranean coast—At the mouths of the Amazon, Orinoco, and Mississippi—The large area where layers can be created by this process.

From the facts enumerated in the last chapter, it appears that on the borders of the ocean, currents and tides co-operating with the waves of the sea are most powerful instruments in the destruction and transportation of rocks; and as numerous tributaries discharge their alluvial burden into the channel of one great river, so we find that many rivers deliver their earthy contents to one marine current, to be borne by it to a distance, and deposited in some deep receptacle of the ocean. The current, besides receiving this tribute of sedimentary matter from streams draining the land, acts also itself on the coast, as does a river on the cliffs which bound a valley. Yet the waste of cliffs by marine currents constitutes on the whole a very insignificant portion of the denudation annually effected by aqueous causes, as I shall point out in the sequel of this chapter (p. 339).

From the facts listed in the last chapter, it seems that along the ocean's edges, currents and tides working together with the sea's waves are powerful forces in breaking down and moving rocks. Just like many tributaries empty their sediment into one major river, we see that several rivers deliver their earthy materials to one ocean current, which carries it away and deposits it in some deep part of the ocean. The current not only receives this flow of sediment from rivers draining the land, but it also shapes the shoreline, much like a river shapes the cliffs of a valley. However, the erosion of cliffs by ocean currents is, overall, a very small part of the total erosion caused by water each year, as I will explain later in this chapter (p. 339).

In inland seas, where the tides are insensible, or on those parts of the borders of the ocean where they are feeble, it is scarcely possible to prevent a harbor at a river's mouth from silting up; for a bar of sand or mud is formed at points where the velocity of the turbid river is checked by the sea, or where the river and a marine current neutralize each other's force. For the current, as we have seen, may, like the river, hold in suspension a large quantity of sediment, or, co-operating with the waves, may cause the progressive motion of a shingle beach in one direction. I have already alluded to the erection of piers and groins at certain places on our southern coast, to arrest the course of the shingle and sand (see p. 318318). The immediate effect of these temporary obstacles is to cause a great accumulation of pebbles on one side of the barrier, after which the beach still moves on round the end of the pier at a greater distance from the land. This system, however, is often attended with a serious evil, for during storms the waves throw suddenly into the harbor the vast heap of pebbles which have collected for years behind the groin or pier, as happened during a great gale (Jan. 1839) at Dover.

In inland seas, where the tides are barely noticeable, or in those parts of the ocean where they are weak, it’s almost impossible to stop a harbor at a river's mouth from becoming silted up; a sand or mud bar forms where the fast-moving river slows down because of the sea, or where the river and a marine current cancel each other out. As we’ve seen, the current can also keep a lot of sediment suspended, or, along with the waves, can move a shingle beach in one direction. I’ve already mentioned the construction of piers and groins at certain spots on our southern coast to block the flow of sand and shingle (see p. 318318). The immediate result of these temporary barriers is a large buildup of pebbles on one side, after which the beach continues to move around the end of the pier further from the land. However, this system often comes with a serious drawback, as during storms the waves can quickly wash a massive pile of pebbles that have built up over the years behind the groin or pier into the harbor, which happened during a major storm (Jan. 1839) at Dover.

The formation and keeping open of large estuaries are due to the combined influence of tidal currents and rivers; for when the tide rises, a large body of water suddenly enters the mouth of the river, where, becoming confined within narrower bounds, while its momentum is not destroyed, it is urged on, and, having to pass through a contracted 338 channel, rises and runs with increased velocity, just as a stream when it reaches the arch of a bridge scarcely large enough to give passage to its waters, rushes with a steep fall through the arch. During the ascent of the tide, a body of fresh water, flowing down in an opposite direction from the higher country, is arrested in its course for several hours; and thus a large lake of fresh and brackish water is accumulated, which, when the sea ebbs, is let loose, as on the removal of an artificial sluice or dam. By the force of this retiring water, the alluvial sediment both of the river and of the sea is swept away, and transported to such a distance from the mouth of the estuary, that a small part only can return with the next tide.

The formation and maintenance of large estuaries happen because of the combined influence of tidal currents and rivers. When the tide rises, a significant amount of water suddenly flows into the mouth of the river. This water becomes confined in narrower space, and while its momentum remains, it accelerates as it passes through a constricted 338 channel, much like how a stream rushes through a bridge arch that is barely big enough to allow its waters to pass. As the tide rises, fresh water flowing down from higher land is held back for several hours, creating a large lake of both fresh and brackish water. When the tide recedes, this water is released, similar to opening an artificial sluice or dam. The force of this outgoing water sweeps away alluvial sediment from both the river and the sea, carrying it far enough from the estuary's mouth that only a small portion can return with the next tide.

It sometimes happens, that during a violent storm a large bar of sand is suddenly made to shift its position, so as to prevent the free influx of the tides, or efflux of river water. Thus about the year 1500 the sands at Bayonne were suddenly thrown across the mouth of the Adour. That river, flowing back upon itself, soon forced a passage to the northward along the sandy plain of Capbreton, till at last it reached the sea at Boucau, at the distance of seven leagues from the point where it had formerly entered. It was not till the year 1579 that the celebrated architect Louis de Foix undertook, at the desire of Henry III., to reopen the ancient channel, which he at last effected with great difficulty.461

It sometimes happens that during a violent storm, a large sandbar suddenly shifts its position, blocking the free flow of tides or river water. For example, around the year 1500, the sands at Bayonne were suddenly pushed across the mouth of the Adour. The river, flowing back on itself, quickly carved a new path to the north along the sandy plain of Capbreton, eventually reaching the sea at Boucau, a distance of seven leagues from where it originally entered. It wasn't until 1579 that the renowned architect Louis de Foix took on the task, at the request of Henry III, to reopen the ancient channel, which he finally accomplished with great difficulty.461

In the estuary of the Thames at London, and in the Gironde, the tide rises only for five hours and ebbs seven, and in all estuaries the water requires a longer time to run down than up; so that the preponderating force is always in the direction which tends to keep open a deep and broad passage. But for reasons already explained, there is naturally a tendency in all estuaries to silt up partially, since eddies, and backwaters, and points where opposing streams meet, are very numerous, and constantly change their position.

In the Thames estuary in London and the Gironde, the tide rises for only five hours and falls for seven, and in all estuaries, the water takes longer to go down than to come up. This means that the dominant force always works to maintain a deep and wide passage. However, for reasons discussed earlier, there is naturally a tendency for all estuaries to become partially silted up, as there are many eddies, backwaters, and areas where opposing currents meet, which constantly change their positions.

Many writers have declared that the gain on our eastern coast, since the earliest periods of history, has more than counterbalanced the loss; but they have been at no pains to calculate the amount of loss, and have often forgotten that, while the new acquisitions are manifest, there are rarely any natural monuments to attest the former existence of the land that has been carried away. They have also taken into their account those tracts artificially recovered, which are often of great agricultural importance, and may remain secure, perhaps, for thousands of years, but which are only a few feet above the mean level of the sea, and are therefore exposed to be overflowed again by a small proportion of the force required to move cliffs of considerable height on our shores. If it were true that the area of land annually abandoned by the sea in estuaries were equal to that invaded by it, there would still be no compensation in kind.

Many writers have claimed that the gains on our eastern coast, since the earliest times in history, have more than made up for the losses; however, they haven't bothered to calculate how much was lost and often overlook the fact that, while the new land gained is obvious, there are rarely any natural markers indicating the previous existence of the land that has been eroded. They've also included in their calculations those areas that have been artificially reclaimed, which are often very important for agriculture and might remain safe for thousands of years, but are only a few feet above the average sea level, leaving them vulnerable to flooding from even a small amount of force needed to move the taller cliffs on our shores. Even if it were true that the area of land that the sea washes away in estuaries is equal to what it invades, there would still be no real compensation.

The tidal current which flows out from the northwest, and bears against the eastern coast of England, transports, as we have seen, materials 339 of various kinds. Aided by the waves, it undermines and sweeps away the granite, gneiss, trap-rocks, and sandstone of Shetland, and removes the gravel and loam of the cliffs of Holderness, Norfolk, and Suffolk, which are between twenty and three hundred feet in height, and which waste at various rates of from one foot to six yards annually. It also bears away, in co-operation with the Thames and the tides, the strata of London clay on the coast of Essex and Sheppey. The sea at the same time consumes the chalk with its flints for many miles continuously on the shores of Kent and Sussex—commits annual ravages on the freshwater beds, capped by a thick covering of chalk-flint gravel, in Hampshire, and continually saps the foundations of the Portland limestone. It receives, besides, during the rainy months, large supplies of pebbles, sand, and mud, which numerous streams from the Grampians, Cheviots, and other chains, send down to the sea. To what regions, then, is all this matter consigned? It is not retained in mechanical suspension by the waters of the ocean, nor does it mix with them in a state of chemical solution—it is deposited somewhere, yet certainly not in the immediate neighborhood of our shores; for, in that case, there would soon be a cessation of the encroachment of the sea, and large tracts of low land, like Romney Marsh, would almost everywhere encircle our island.

The tidal current that flows out from the northwest and hits the eastern coast of England carries, as we've seen, various types of materials. 339 With the help of the waves, it erodes and washes away the granite, gneiss, trap rocks, and sandstone from Shetland and removes the gravel and loam from the cliffs of Holderness, Norfolk, and Suffolk, which rise between twenty and three hundred feet, eroding at rates of one foot to six yards each year. It also moves away the layers of London clay along the Essex and Sheppey coasts, working alongside the Thames and the tides. Meanwhile, the sea continuously erodes the chalk and flints along the shores of Kent and Sussex, causing yearly damage to the freshwater beds covered by a thick layer of chalk-flint gravel in Hampshire, and steadily undermining the foundations of the Portland limestone. Additionally, during the rainy months, it receives large amounts of pebbles, sand, and mud from various streams coming down from the Grampians, Cheviots, and other mountain ranges. So where does all this material end up? It isn’t kept in mechanical suspension by the ocean’s waters, nor does it dissolve in them—it gets deposited somewhere, but certainly not close to our shores; otherwise, the sea would soon stop encroaching, and large areas of low land, like Romney Marsh, would almost completely surround our island.

As there is now a depth of water exceeding thirty feet, in some spots where towns like Dunwich flourished but a few centuries ago, it is clear that the current not only carries far away the materials of the wasted cliffs, but is capable also of excavating the bed of the sea to a certain moderate depth.

As there is now a depth of water over thirty feet in some areas where towns like Dunwich thrived just a few centuries ago, it's clear that the current not only washes away the materials from the crumbling cliffs but also has the ability to dig into the sea floor to a certain moderate depth.

So great is the quantity of matter held in suspension by the tidal current on our shores, that the waters are in some places artificially introduced into certain lands below the level of the sea; and by repeating this operation, which is called "warping," for two or three years, considerable tracts have been raised, in the estuary of the Humber, to the height of about six feet. If a current, charged with such materials, meets with deep depressions in the bed of the ocean, it must often fill them up; just as a river, when it meets with a lake in its course, fills it gradually with sediment.

The amount of material suspended by the tidal current along our shores is so vast that water is sometimes pumped into areas of land below sea level. By repeating this process, known as "warping," for two or three years, significant areas have been raised in the Humber estuary to about six feet in height. When a current carrying these materials encounters deep spots in the ocean floor, it often fills them in, just like a river fills a lake with sediment as it flows into it.

I have said (p. 337) that the action of the waves and currents on sea-cliffs, or their power to remove matter from above to below the sea-level, is insignificant in comparison with the power of rivers to perform the same task. As an illustration we may take the coast of Holderness described in the last chapter (p. 304). It is composed, as we have seen, of very destructible materials, is thirty-six miles long, and its average height may be taken at forty feet. As it has wasted away at the rate of two and a quarter yards annually, for a long period, it will be found on calculation that the quantity of matter thrown down into the sea every year, and removed by the current, amounts to 51,321,600 cubic feet. It has been shown that the united Ganges and Brahmapootra carry down to the Bay of Bengal 40,000,000,000 of cubic feet 340 of solid matter every year, so that their transporting power is no less than 780 times greater than that of the sea on the coast above-mentioned; and in order to produce a result equal to that of the two Indian rivers, we must have a line of wasting coast, like that of Holderness, nearly 28,000 miles in length, or longer than the entire circumference of the globe by above 3000 miles. The reason of so great a difference in the results may be understood when we reflect that the operations of the ocean are limited to a single line of cliff surrounding a large area, whereas great rivers with their tributaries, and the mountain torrents which flow into them, act simultaneously on a length of bank almost indefinite.

I have mentioned (p. 337) that the effects of waves and currents on sea-cliffs, or their ability to move material from above sea level to below, are minor compared to the capacity of rivers to do the same thing. For example, we can look at the coast of Holderness discussed in the last chapter (p. 304). It is made up of very erodible materials, stretches for thirty-six miles, and has an average height of about forty feet. Since it has eroded at a rate of two and a quarter yards per year for a long time, calculations show that the amount of material washed into the sea each year and carried away by the current totals 51,321,600 cubic feet. It has been shown that the combined Ganges and Brahmaputra rivers deliver 40,000,000,000 cubic feet of solid material to the Bay of Bengal every year, which means their transporting capacity is 780 times greater than that of the sea along the aforementioned coast. To achieve results equal to those of the two Indian rivers, we would need a line of eroding coast, like that of Holderness, nearly 28,000 miles long, which is over 3,000 miles longer than the entire circumference of the earth. This significant difference in outcomes can be understood when we consider that the ocean's effects are confined to a single line of cliffs surrounding a large area, while large rivers, along with their tributaries and the mountain streams feeding into them, simultaneously act on a bank that is nearly limitless.

Nevertheless we are by no means entitled to infer, that the denuding force of the great ocean is a geological cause of small efficacy, or inferior to that of rivers. Its chief influence is exerted at moderate depths below the surface, on all those areas which are slowly rising, or are attempting, as it were, to rise above the sea. From data hitherto obtained respecting subterranean movements, we can scarcely speculate on an average rate of upheaval of more than two or three feet in a century. An elevation to this amount is taking place in Scandinavia, and probably in many submarine areas as vast as those which we know to be sinking from the proofs derived from circular lagoon islands or coral atolls. (See chap. 50.) Suppose strata as destructible as those of the Wealden, or the lower and upper cretaceous formation, or the tertiary deposits of the British Isles to be thus slowly upheaved, how readily might they all be swept away by waves and currents in an open sea! How entirely might each stratum disappear as it was brought up successively and exposed to the breakers! Shoals of wide extent might be produced, but it is difficult to conceive how any continent could ever be formed under such circumstances. Were it not indeed for the hardness and toughness of the crystalline and volcanic rocks, which are often capable of resisting the action of the waves, few lands might ever emerge from the midst of an open sea.

Nevertheless, we can't assume that the powerful forces of the ocean are a geological cause of little impact, or less significant than rivers. Its main influence occurs at moderate depths below the surface, affecting areas that are slowly rising or trying to rise above the sea. Based on the data we've gathered about underground movements, we can't really guess that the average rate of uplift is more than two or three feet per century. A rise of this magnitude is happening in Scandinavia, and likely in many underwater areas as large as those that we know are sinking, as shown by circular lagoon islands or coral atolls. (See chap. 50.) If we consider layers as easily eroded as those of the Wealden, or the lower and upper cretaceous formations, or the tertiary deposits of the British Isles being slowly uplifted, they could easily be washed away by waves and currents in open water! Each layer could completely vanish as it gets successively raised and exposed to the waves! Large shoals might form, but it’s hard to imagine how any continent could develop under such conditions. If it weren't for the hardness and durability of crystalline and volcanic rocks, which can often withstand wave action, very few landmasses might ever rise from the depths of the ocean.

Supposed filling up of the German Ocean.—The German Ocean is deepest on the Norwegian side, where the soundings give 190 fathoms; but the mean depth of the whole basin may be stated at no more than thirty-one fathoms.462 The bed of this sea is traversed by several enormous banks, the greatest of which is the Dogger Bank, extending for upwards of 354 miles from north to south. The whole superficies of these shoals is equal to about one-third of the whole extent of England and Scotland. The average height of the banks measures, according to Mr. Stevenson, about seventy-eight feet; the upper portion of them consisting of fine and coarse siliceous sand, mixed with comminuted corals and shells.463 It had been supposed that these vast submarine hills were made up bodily of loose materials supplied from the waste of the English, Dutch, and other coasts; but the survey of the North Sea, 341 conducted by Captain Hewett, affords ground for suspecting this opinion to be erroneous. If such immense mounds of sand and mud had been accumulated under the influence of currents, the same causes ought nearly to have reduced to one level the entire bottom of the German Ocean; instead of which some long narrow ravines are found to intersect the banks. One of these varies from seventeen to forty-four fathoms in depth, and has very precipitous sides; in one part, called the "Inner Silver Pits," it is fifty-five fathoms deep. The shallowest parts of the Dogger Bank were found to be forty-two feet under water, except in one place, where the wreck of a ship had caused a shoal. Such uniformity in the minimum depth of water seems to imply that the currents, which vary in their velocity from a mile to two miles and a half per hour, have power to prevent the accumulation of drift matter in places of less depth.

Supposed filling up of the German Ocean.—The German Ocean is deepest on the Norwegian side, where measurements show a depth of 190 fathoms; however, the average depth of the entire basin is no more than thirty-one fathoms.462 The floor of this sea is covered by several massive banks, the largest being the Dogger Bank, which stretches over 354 miles from north to south. The total area of these shallow spots is roughly equal to about one-third of the entire area of England and Scotland. According to Mr. Stevenson, the average height of the banks is around seventy-eight feet, with the top layer made up of fine and coarse siliceous sand mixed with crushed corals and shells.463 It was believed that these enormous underwater hills were formed entirely from loose materials that washed away from the coasts of England, the Netherlands, and others; however, the North Sea survey conducted by Captain Hewett raises doubts about this belief. If such massive mounds of sand and mud had built up due to currents, the same forces would likely have leveled the entire bottom of the German Ocean. Instead, there are long, narrow ravines cutting through the banks. One of these ravines ranges from seventeen to forty-four fathoms deep and has very steep sides; in one section, known as the "Inner Silver Pits," it reaches fifty-five fathoms in depth. The shallowest areas of the Dogger Bank were found to be forty-two feet underwater, except in one spot where a shipwreck created a shoal. This consistency in the minimum depth of water suggests that the currents, which vary in speed from one mile to two and a half miles per hour, are strong enough to prevent the buildup of drift materials in shallower areas.

Strata deposited by currents.—It appears extraordinary, that in some tracts of the sea, adjoining the coast of England, where we know that currents are not only sweeping along rocky masses, thrown down, from time to time, from the high cliffs, but also occasionally scooping out channels in the regular strata, there should exist fragile shells and tender zoophytes in abundance, which live uninjured by these violent movements. The ocean, however, is in this respect a counterpart of the land; and as, on the continents, rivers may undermine their banks, uproot trees, and roll along sand and gravel, while their waters are inhabited by testacea and fish, and their alluvial plains are adorned with rich vegetation and forests, so the sea may be traversed by rapid currents, and its bed may here and there suffer great local derangement, without any interruption of the general order and tranquillity. It has been ascertained by soundings in all parts of the world, that where new deposits are taking place in the sea, coarse sand and small pebbles commonly occur near the shore, while farther from land, and in deeper water, finer sand and broken shells are spread out over the bottom. Still farther out, the finest mud and ooze are alone met with. Mr. Austen observes that this rule holds good in every part of the English Channel examined by him. He also informs us, that where the tidal current runs rapidly in what are called "races," where surface undulations are perceived in the calmest weather, over deep banks, the discoloration of the water does not arise from the power of such a current to disturb the bottom at a depth of 40 or 80 fathoms, as some have supposed. In these cases, a column of water sometimes 500 feet in height, is moving onwards with the tide clear and transparent above, while the lower portion holds fine sediment in suspension (a fact ascertained by soundings), when suddenly it impinges upon a bank, and its height is reduced to 300 feet. It is thus made to boil up and flow off at the surface, a process which forces up the lower strata of water charged with fine particles of mud, which in their passage from the coast had gradually sunk to a depth of 300 feet or more.464

Strata deposited by currents.—It seems remarkable that in some areas of the sea near the coast of England, where we know strong currents are not only moving rocky masses that occasionally fall from the high cliffs, but also sometimes eroding channels in the regular layers, there are delicate shells and soft zophites in large numbers that remain unharmed by these violent movements. The ocean, in this sense, mirrors the land; just as on continents, rivers can erode their banks, uproot trees, and carry sand and gravel, while their waters are home to shellfish and fish, and their floodplains are rich with vegetation and forests, the sea can have fast currents and its floor can experience significant disruptions without upsetting the overall order and calm. Measurements taken around the world show that where new deposits are forming in the sea, coarse sand and small pebbles are usually found near the shore, while farther out to sea, in deeper waters, finer sand and broken shells are spread along the bottom. Even farther out, only the finest mud and ooze are found. Mr. Austen notes that this pattern applies in every part of the English Channel he has examined. He also points out that where the tidal current flows quickly in areas called "races," where surface waves can be seen even in calm weather over deep banks, the murky water does not come from the current’s ability to disturb the bottom at depths of 40 or 80 fathoms, as some have believed. In such cases, a column of water that sometimes reaches 500 feet high moves with the tide, remaining clear and transparent above while the lower part carries fine sediment in suspension (a fact confirmed by measurements). When this current hits a bank, its height drops to 300 feet, causing it to churn and flow over the surface. This process pushes up the lower layers of water loaded with fine particles of mud, which had gradually settled to a depth of 300 feet or more as it made its way from the coast.464

342 One important character in the formations produced by currents is, the immense extent over which they may be the means of diffusing homogeneous mixtures, for these are often coextensive with a great line of coast; and, by comparison with their deposits, the deltas of rivers must shrink into significance. In the Mediterranean, the same current which is rapidly destroying many parts of the African coast, between the Straits of Gibraltar and the Nile, checks also the growth of the delta of the Nile, and drifts the sediment of that great river to the eastward. To this source may be attributed the rapid accretions of land on parts of the Syrian shores where rivers do not enter.

342 One important factor in the formations created by currents is the vast area over which they can spread uniform mixtures, as these often extend along extensive coastlines; compared to them, river deltas seem relatively small. In the Mediterranean, the same current that is quickly eroding many sections of the African coast between the Straits of Gibraltar and the Nile also slows the growth of the Nile delta and carries the sediment of that major river eastward. This source can explain the rapid buildup of land along certain parts of the Syrian coast where no rivers flow in.

Among the greatest deposits now in progress, and of which the distribution is chiefly determined by currents, we may class those between the mouths of the Amazon and the southern coast of North America. Captain Sabine found that the equatorial current before mentioned (p. 292) was running with the rapidity of four miles an hour where it crosses the stream of the Amazon, which river preserves part of its original impulse, and has its waters not wholly mingled with those of the ocean at the distance of 300 miles from its mouth.465 The sediment of the Amazon is thus constantly carried to the northwest as far as to the mouths of the Orinoco, and an immense tract of swamp is formed along the coast of Guiana, with a long range of muddy shoals bordering the marshes, and becoming converted into land.466 The sediment of the Orinoco is partly detained, and settles near its mouth, causing the shores of Trinidad to extend rapidly, and is partly swept away into the Carribean Sea by the Guinea current. According to Humboldt, much sediment is carried again out of the Carribean Sea into the Gulf of Mexico.

Among the largest deposits currently in progress, primarily shaped by currents, are those between the mouths of the Amazon and the southern coast of North America. Captain Sabine discovered that the aforementioned equatorial current (p. 292) was flowing at a speed of four miles per hour where it intersects with the Amazon River, which still retains some of its original momentum, and its waters are not completely mixed with those of the ocean even 300 miles from its mouth.465 The sediment from the Amazon is continuously transported northwest as far as the mouths of the Orinoco, creating a vast area of swamp along the coast of Guiana, accompanied by a long stretch of muddy shoals along the marshes, which eventually become land.466 The sediment from the Orinoco is partially retained and settles near its mouth, causing the shores of Trinidad to expand rapidly, while some is carried away into the Caribbean Sea by the Guinea current. According to Humboldt, a significant amount of sediment is transported out of the Caribbean Sea back into the Gulf of Mexico.

It should not be overlooked that marine currents, even on coasts where there are no large rivers, may still be the agents of spreading not only sand and pebbles, but the finest mud, far and wide over the bottom of the ocean. For several thousand miles along the western coast of South America, comprising the larger parts of Peru and Chili, there is a perpetual rolling of shingle along the shore, part of which, as Mr. Darwin has shown, are incessantly reduced to the finest mud by the waves, and swept into the depths of the Pacific by the tides and currents. The same author however has remarked that, notwithstanding the great force of the waves on that shore, all rocks 60 feet under water are covered by sea-weed, showing that the bed of the sea is not denuded at that depth, the effects of the winds being comparatively superficial.

It’s important to note that ocean currents, even along coasts without big rivers, can still spread not just sand and pebbles, but also the finest mud, widely across the ocean floor. For several thousand miles along the western coast of South America, covering most of Peru and Chile, there's a constant movement of gravel along the shore, part of which, as Mr. Darwin has shown, is continuously ground down into fine mud by the waves and carried into the depths of the Pacific by the tides and currents. However, the same author noted that, despite the strong waves along that shore, all rocks 60 feet underwater are covered with seaweed, indicating that the seabed isn't stripped at that depth, and the wind’s impact is relatively shallow.

In regard to the distribution of sediment by currents it may be observed, that the rate of subsidence of the finer mud carried down by every great river into the ocean, or of that caused by the rolling of the waves upon a shore, must be extremely slow; for the more minute the separate particles of mud, the slower will they sink to the bottom, and 343 the sooner will they acquire what is called their terminal velocity. It is well known that a solid body, descending through a resisting medium, falls by the force of gravity, which is constant, but its motion is resisted by the medium more and more as its velocity increases, until the resistance becomes sufficient to counteract the farther increase of velocity. For example, a leaden ball, one inch diameter, falling through air of density as at the earth's surface, will never acquire greater velocity than 260 feet per second, and, in water, its greatest velocity will be 8 feet 6 inches per second. If the diameter of the ball were 1/100 of an inch, the terminal velocities in air would be 26 feet, and in water ·86 of a foot per second.

When it comes to how currents distribute sediment, it's important to note that the rate at which finer mud gets carried by major rivers into the ocean, or how it settles due to waves rolling onto a shore, is very slow. The smaller the particles of mud, the slower they will sink to the bottom, and the quicker they will reach what’s known as their terminal velocity. It’s well understood that a solid object falling through a resisting medium is pulled down by gravity—which is constant—but its motion faces increasing resistance from the medium as its speed increases, until the resistance is strong enough to stop any further speed increase. For instance, a lead ball with a diameter of one inch falling through air at sea level will never go faster than 260 feet per second, and in water, its top speed will be 8 feet 6 inches per second. If the ball's diameter were 1/100 of an inch, its terminal velocities would be 26 feet in air and 0.86 feet per second in water.

Now, every chemist is familiar with the fact, that minute particles descend with extreme slowness through water, the extent of their surface being very great in proportion to their weight, and the resistance of the fluid depending on the amount of surface. A precipitate of sulphate of baryta, for example, will sometimes require more than five or six hours to subside one inch;467 while oxalate and phosphate of lime require nearly an hour to subside about an inch and a half and two inches respectively,468 so exceedingly small are the particles of which these substances consist.

Now, every chemist knows that tiny particles sink very slowly through water because their surface area is very large compared to their weight, and the fluid's resistance is based on that surface area. A precipitate of barium sulfate, for example, can take more than five or six hours to settle one inch;467 while calcium oxalate and calcium phosphate take nearly an hour to settle about one and a half inches and two inches, respectively,468 illustrating just how incredibly small the particles of these substances are.

When we recollect that the depth of the ocean is supposed frequently to exceed three miles, and that currents run through different parts of that ocean at the rate of four miles an hour, and when at the same time we consider that some fine mud carried away from the mouths of rivers and from sea-beaches, where there is a heavy surf, as well as the impalpable powder showered down by volcanoes, may subside at the rate of only an inch per hour, we shall be prepared to find examples of the transportation of sediment over areas of indefinite extent.

When we remember that the depth of the ocean is often thought to be more than three miles, and that currents move through different parts of the ocean at about four miles an hour, and at the same time consider that some fine mud washed away from river mouths and beach areas with strong waves, as well as the tiny particles released by volcanoes, might settle at a rate of only an inch per hour, we should expect to see examples of sediment being transported over vast areas.

It is not uncommon for the emery powder used in polishing glass to take more than an hour to sink one foot. Suppose mud composed of coarser particles to fall at the rate of two feet per hour, and these to be discharged into that part of the Gulf Stream which preserves a mean velocity of three miles an hour for a distance of two thousand miles; in twenty-eight days these particles will be carried 2016 miles, and will have fallen only to a depth of 224 fathoms.

It’s not unusual for the emery powder used in polishing glass to take over an hour to settle one foot. Now, if we consider mud made of larger particles falling at a rate of two feet per hour, and these particles being released into the section of the Gulf Stream that maintains an average speed of three miles an hour for two thousand miles, then in twenty-eight days these particles will be carried 2016 miles and will have only sunk to a depth of 224 fathoms.

In this example, however, it is assumed that the current retains its superficial velocity at the depth of 224 fathoms, for which we have as yet no data, although we have seen that the motion of a current may continue at the depth of 100 fathoms. (See above, p. 28.) Experiments should be made to ascertain the rate of currents at considerable distances from the surface, and the time taken by the finest sediment to settle in sea-water of a given depth, and then the geologist may determine the area over which homogeneous mixtures may be simultaneously distributed in certain seas.

In this example, it’s assumed that the current maintains its surface speed at a depth of 224 fathoms, for which we still have no data. However, we’ve noted that a current's motion can continue at a depth of 100 fathoms. (See above, p. 28.) Experiments need to be conducted to find out the current speeds at significant depths and the time it takes for fine sediment to settle in seawater at a given depth. Then, geologists can identify the areas where uniform mixtures can be found simultaneously in certain seas.


CHAPTER XXII.

IGNEOUS CAUSES.

Changes of the inorganic world, continued—Igneous causes—Division of the subject—Distinct volcanic regions—Region of the Andes—System of volcanoes extending from the Aleutian isles to the Molucca and Sunda islands—Polynesian archipelago—Volcanic region extending from Central Asia to the Azores—Tradition of deluges on the shores of the Bosphorus, Hellespont, and Grecian isles—Periodical alternation of earthquakes in Syria and Southern Italy—Western limits of the European region—Earthquakes rarer and more feeble as we recede from the centres of volcanic action. Extinct volcanoes not to be included in lines of active vents.

Changes in the inorganic world, continued—Volcanic causes—Division of the topic—Distinct volcanic regions—Region of the Andes—A system of volcanoes stretching from the Aleutian Islands to the Molucca and Sunda Islands—Polynesian archipelago—Volcanic area extending from Central Asia to the Azores—Legends of floods on the shores of the Bosphorus, Hellespont, and Greek islands—Regular alternation of earthquakes in Syria and Southern Italy—Western boundaries of the European region—Earthquakes are less common and weaker as we move away from the centers of volcanic activity. Extinct volcanoes are not to be counted among active vents.

We have hitherto considered the changes wrought, since the times of history and tradition, by the continued action of aqueous causes on the earth's surface; and we have next to examine those resulting from igneous agency. As the rivers and springs on the land, and the tides and currents in the sea, have, with some slight modifications, been fixed and constant to certain localities from the earliest periods of which we have any records, so the volcano and the earthquake have, with few exceptions, continued, during the same lapse of time, to disturb the same regions. But as there are signs, on almost every part of our continent, of great power having been exerted by running water on the surface of the land, and by waves, tides, and currents on cliffs bordering the sea, where, in modern times, no rivers have excavated, and no waves or tidal currents undermined—so we find signs of volcanic vents and violent subterranean movements in places where the action of fire or internal heat has long been dormant. We can explain why the intensity of the force of aqueous causes should be developed in succession in different districts. Currents, for example, tides, and the waves of the sea, cannot destroy coasts, shape out or silt up estuaries, break through isthmuses, and annihilate islands, form shoals in one place, and remove them from another, without the direction and position of their destroying and transporting power becoming transferred to new localities. Neither can the relative levels of the earth's crust, above and beneath the waters, vary from time to time, as they are admitted to have varied at former periods, and as it will be demonstrated that they still do, without the continents being, in the course of ages, modified, and even entirely altered, in their external configuration. Such events must clearly be accompanied by a complete change in the volume, velocity, and direction of the streams and land floods to which certain regions give passage. That we should find, therefore, cliffs where the sea once committed ravages, and from which it has now retired—estuaries where high tides once rose, but which are now dried up—valleys hollowed out by water, where no streams now flow, is no more than we should 345 expect; these and similar phenomena are the necessary consequences of physical causes now in operation; and if there be no instability in the laws of nature, similar fluctuations must recur again and again in time to come.

We have so far looked at the changes brought about, since historical and traditional times, by the ongoing effects of water on the earth's surface; now we need to examine those caused by volcanic activity. Just as rivers and springs on land, and tides and currents in the sea, have largely stayed the same in specific locations since the earliest records we have, volcanoes and earthquakes have, with a few exceptions, continued to disrupt the same areas over time. However, we see signs across much of our continent of significant power being exerted by flowing water on land and by waves, tides, and currents on cliffs along the coast, where, in more recent times, no rivers have carved paths and no waves or tidal currents have eroded—just as we also observe signs of volcanic vents and intense underground movements in places where volcanic activity or heat has been inactive for a long time. We can understand why the strength of water's effects should vary from one area to another over time. For instance, currents, tides, and sea waves cannot erode coastlines, shape or silt up estuaries, break through isthmuses, or obliterate islands, nor can they create shoals in one area and remove them from another, without the direction and strength of their destructive and transporting power shifting to new locations. Additionally, the relative heights of the earth's crust, above and below the water, can't change over time, as they are known to have changed in the past and will continue to do so, without the continents being modified or even completely reshaped over ages. Such changes must clearly be accompanied by a significant shift in the volume, speed, and path of the rivers and floods that affect certain regions. Therefore, it makes sense that we find cliffs where the sea once caused damage, but from which it has now receded—estuaries where high tides used to rise, but which are now parched—valleys carved by water, where no rivers currently flow; these and similar phenomena are simply the expected results of physical forces at work today. If the laws of nature remain stable, similar fluctuations must recur again and again in the future.

But, however natural it may be that the force of running water in numerous valleys, and of tides and currents in many tracts of the sea, should now be spent, it is by no means so easy to explain why the violence of the earthquake and the fire of the volcano should also have become locally extinct at successive periods. We can look back to the time when the marine strata, whereon the great mass of Etna rests, had no existence; and that time is extremely modern in the earth's history. This alone affords ground for anticipating that the eruptions of Etna will one day cease.

But even though it makes sense that the force of flowing water in many valleys, along with tides and currents in various parts of the sea, should now be spent, it's not as easy to explain why the violent earthquakes and volcanic eruptions have also died out in different areas over time. We can look back to a time when the marine layers, which the massive Mount Etna sits on, didn't even exist; and that time is relatively recent in the history of the Earth. This alone leads us to believe that the eruptions of Etna will eventually come to an end.

Neither does it burn with sulfurous furnaces, Aetna. It will always be fiery, for it has not always been fiery, (Ovid, Metam. book 15-340,)

are the memorable words which are put into the mouth of Pythagoras by the Roman poet, and they are followed by speculations as to the cause of volcanic vents shifting their positions. Whatever doubts the philosopher expresses as to the nature of these causes, it is assumed, as incontrovertible, that the points of eruption will hereafter vary, because they have formerly done so; a principle of reasoning which, as I have endeavored to show in former chapters, has been too much set at naught by some of the earlier schools of geology, which refused to conclude that great revolutions in the earth's surface are now in progress, or that they will take place hereafter, because they have often been repeated in former ages.

are the memorable words that the Roman poet attributes to Pythagoras, followed by thoughts on why volcanic vents change their locations. Despite the philosopher's uncertainties about the nature of these causes, it's taken as a given that eruption points will vary in the future, because they have done so in the past; this reasoning principle, as I've tried to demonstrate in earlier chapters, has been largely overlooked by some of the earlier schools of geology, which refused to accept that significant changes in the earth's surface are currently happening or will occur in the future, because they have often been observed in past ages.

Division of the subject.—Volcanic action may be defined to be "the influence exerted by the heated interior of the earth on its external covering." If we adopt this definition, without connecting it, as Humboldt has done, with the theory of secular refrigeration, or the cooling down of an original heated and fluid nucleus, we may then class under a general head all the subterranean phenomena, whether of volcanoes, or earthquakes, and those insensible movements of the land, by which, as will afterwards appear, large districts may be depressed or elevated, without convulsions. According to this view, I shall consider first, the volcano; secondly, the earthquake; thirdly, the rising or sinking of land in countries where there are no volcanoes or earthquakes; fourthly, the probable causes of the changes which result from subterranean agency.

Division of the subject.—Volcanic action can be defined as "the influence exerted by the heated interior of the earth on its outer layer." If we use this definition, without linking it, as Humboldt has, to the theory of gradual cooling or the chilling of an originally hot and molten core, we can categorize all underground phenomena under a general heading, whether they involve volcanoes, earthquakes, or those subtle movements of the land that, as will be shown later, can cause large areas to rise or sink without major disruptions. From this perspective, I will first discuss the volcano; second, the earthquake; third, the rising or sinking of land in places without volcanoes or earthquakes; and fourth, the likely causes of the changes brought about by underground activity.

It is a very general opinion that earthquakes and volcanoes have a common origin; for both are confined to certain regions, although the subterranean movements are least violent in the immediate proximity of volcanic vents, especially where the discharge of aeriform fluids and melted rock is made constantly from the same crater. But as there are particular regions, to which both the points of eruption and the movements of great earthquakes are confined, I shall begin by tracing out the 346 geographical boundaries of some of these, that the reader may be aware of the magnificent scale on which the agency of subterranean fire is now simultaneously developed. Over the whole of the vast tracts alluded to, active volcanic vents are distributed at intervals, and most commonly arranged in a linear direction. Throughout the intermediate spaces there is often abundant evidence that the subterranean fire is at work continuously, for the ground is convulsed from time to time by earthquakes; gaseous vapors, especially carbonic acid gas, are disengaged plentifully from the soil; springs often issue at a very high temperature, and their waters are usually impregnated with the same mineral matters as are discharged by volcanoes during eruptions.

It’s a widely held belief that earthquakes and volcanoes share a common cause; both are limited to specific areas, even though the underground movements tend to be less intense near volcanic vents, particularly where gases and molten rock are consistently released from the same crater. However, since there are certain regions where both eruption points and large earthquake movements are concentrated, I will start by outlining the geographical boundaries of some of these areas, so the reader can appreciate the impressive scale at which underground fire is currently active. Across these vast regions, active volcanic vents are scattered at intervals and are most often arranged in a linear pattern. In the spaces in between, there’s frequent evidence that underground fire is always at work, as the ground is periodically shaken by earthquakes; gases, especially carbon dioxide, are released abundantly from the soil; hot springs often emerge at very high temperatures, and their waters are typically infused with the same minerals found in volcanic eruptions.

VOLCANIC REGIONS.

Region of the Andes.—Of these great regions, that of the Andes of South America is one of the best defined, extending from the southward of Chili to the northward of Quito, from about lat. 43° S. to about 2° N. of the equator. In this range, however, comprehending forty-five degrees of latitude, there is an alternation on a grand scale of districts of active with those of extinct volcanoes, or which, if not spent, have at least been dormant for the last three centuries. How long an interval of rest may entitle us to consider a volcano as entirely extinct is not easily determined; but we know that in Ischia there intervened between two consecutive eruptions a pause of seventeen centuries; and the discovery of America is an event of far too recent a date to allow us even to conjecture whether different portions of the Andes, nearly the whole of which are subject to earthquakes, may not experience alternately a cessation and renewal of eruptions.

Region of the Andes.—Among these major regions, the Andes of South America is one of the most clearly defined, stretching from the south of Chile to the north of Quito, from about lat. 43° S. to about 2° N. of the equator. In this range, which covers forty-five degrees of latitude, there is a large-scale alternation between areas of active and extinct volcanoes, or those that, if not completely spent, have at least been dormant for the last three centuries. It’s hard to determine how long a volcano needs to be quiet to be considered completely extinct; however, we know that in Ischia, there was a gap of seventeen centuries between two eruptions. The discovery of America is too recent for us to even speculate whether different parts of the Andes, most of which are subject to earthquakes, might experience alternating periods of inactivity and renewed eruptions.

The first line of active vents which have been seen in eruption in the Andes extends from lat. 43° 28' S.; or, from Yantales, opposite the isle of Chiloe, to Coquimbo, in lat. 30° S.; to these thirteen degrees of latitude succeed more than eight degrees in which no recent volcanic eruptions have been observed. We then come to the volcanoes of Bolivia and Peru, reaching six degrees from S. to N., or from lat. 21° S. to lat. 15° S. Between the Peruvian volcanoes and those of Quito, another space intervenes of no less than fourteen degrees of latitude, said to be free from volcanic action so far as yet known. The volcanoes of Quito then succeed, beginning about 100 geographical miles south of the equator, and continuing for about 130 miles north of the line, when there occurs another undisturbed interval of more than six degrees of latitude, after which we arrive at the volcanoes of Guatemala or Central America, north of the Isthmus of Panama.469

The first line of active volcanoes in the Andes stretches from latitude 43° 28' S, near Yantales, across from the island of Chiloe, to Coquimbo at latitude 30° S. After these thirteen degrees of latitude, there are over eight degrees where no recent volcanic eruptions have been reported. Next, we have the volcanoes of Bolivia and Peru, which span six degrees from south to north, or from latitude 21° S to latitude 15° S. Between the Peruvian volcanoes and those in Quito, there is another gap of fourteen degrees of latitude, which is believed to be free from volcanic activity, at least so far. After that, we encounter the volcanoes of Quito, starting about 100 geographical miles south of the equator and continuing for about 130 miles north of the equator, before hitting another quiet stretch of more than six degrees of latitude. Finally, we reach the volcanoes of Guatemala or Central America, located north of the Isthmus of Panama.469

Having thus traced out the line from south to north, I may first state, in regard to the numerous vents of Chili, that the volcanoes of Yantales 347 and Osorno were in eruption during the great earthquake of 1835, at the same moment that the land was shaken in Chiloe, and in some parts of the Chilian coast permanently upheaved; whilst at Juan Fernandez, at the distance of no less than 720 geographical miles from Yantales, an eruption took place beneath the sea. Some of the volcanoes of Chili are of great height, as that of Antuco, in lat. 37° 40' S., the summit of which is at least 16,000 feet above the sea. From the flanks of this volcano, at a great height, immense currents of lava have issued, one of which flowed in the year 1828. This event is said to be an exception in the general rule; few volcanoes in the Andes, and none of those in Quito, having been seen in modern times to pour out lava, but having merely ejected vapor or scoriæ.

Having mapped the route from south to north, I can first mention the various volcanoes in Chile. The Yantales and Osorno volcanoes were erupting during the major earthquake of 1835, at the same time that the land was shaking in Chiloe and some areas of the Chilean coast experienced permanent uplift. Meanwhile, 720 geographical miles away from Yantales, an eruption occurred beneath the sea at Juan Fernandez. Some of Chile's volcanoes are quite tall, like Antuco, located at latitude 37° 40' S, which rises at least 16,000 feet above sea level. From this volcano's slopes, massive lava flows have emerged, with one notable flow occurring in 1828. This is considered an exception to the general trend, as few volcanoes in the Andes, and none in Quito, have been observed in modern times to erupt lava; they typically just release vapor or ash.

Both the basaltic (or augitic) lavas, and those of the felspathic class, occur in Chili and other parts of the Andes; but the volcanic rocks of the felspathic family are said by Von Buch to be generally not trachyte, but a rock which has been called andesite, or a mixture of augite and albite. The last-mentioned mineral contains soda instead of the potash found in common felspar.

Both basaltic (or augitic) lavas and those from the feldspathic class are found in Chile and other areas of the Andes. However, Von Buch claims that the volcanic rocks from the feldspathic family are generally not trachyte, but rather a rock known as andesite, which is a blend of augite and albite. The latter mineral contains soda instead of the potash found in common feldspar.

The volcano of Rancagua, lat. 34° 15' S., is said to be always throwing out ashes and vapors like Stromboli, a proof of the permanently heated state of certain parts of the interior of the earth below. A year rarely passes in Chili without some slight shocks of earthquakes, and in certain districts not a month. Those shocks which come from the side of the ocean are the most violent, and the same is said to be the case in Peru. The town of Copiapo was laid waste by this terrible scourge in the years 1773, 1796, and 1819, or in both cases after regular intervals of twenty-three years. There have, however, been other shocks in that country in the periods intervening between the dates above mentioned, although probably all less severe, at least on the exact site of Copiapo. The evidence against a regular recurrence of volcanic convulsions at stated periods is so strong as a general fact, that we must be on our guard against attaching too much importance to a few striking but probably accidental coincidences. Among these last might be adduced the case of Lima, violently shaken by an earthquake on the 17th of June, 1578, and again on the very same day, 1678; or the eruptions of Coseguina in the year 1709 and 1809, which are the only two recorded of that volcano previous to that of 1835.470

The volcano in Rancagua, at 34° 15' S., is constantly spewing ash and vapor like Stromboli, which shows that some parts of the Earth's interior are always hot. Rarely a year goes by in Chile without minor earthquakes, and in some areas, they happen almost every month. The most intense shocks come from the ocean side, and it’s similar in Peru. The town of Copiapó was devastated by this dreadful phenomenon in 1773, 1796, and 1819, which were twenty-three years apart. However, there have been other tremors in that country between those years, though likely less severe, at least at the exact site of Copiapó. The evidence against a regular pattern of volcanic activity at specific intervals is so compelling that we should be cautious about giving too much weight to a few notable but likely random coincidences. One such instance is Lima, which was hit hard by an earthquake on June 17, 1578, and again on the same day in 1678; or the eruptions of Coseguina in 1709 and 1809, which are the only two documented eruptions of that volcano before 1835.470

Of the permanent upheaval of land after earthquakes in Chili, I shall have occasion to speak in the next chapter, when it will also be seen that great shocks often coincide with eruptions, either submarine or from the cones of the Andes, showing the identity of the force which elevates continents with that which causes volcanic outbursts.471

Of the lasting changes in land after earthquakes in Chile, I will discuss it in the next chapter, when it will also become clear that major shocks often happen alongside eruptions, whether underwater or from the cones of the Andes, demonstrating that the same force that lifts continents is also responsible for volcanic eruptions.471

The space between Chili and Peru, in which no volcanic action has been observed, is 160 nautical leagues from south to north. It is, however, as Von Buch observes, that part of the Andes which is least 348 known, being thinly peopled, and in some parts entirely desert. The volcanoes of Peru rise from a lofty platform to vast heights above the level of the sea, from 17,000 to 20,000 feet. The lava which has issued from Viejo, lat. 16° 55' S., accompanied by pumice, is composed of a mixture of crystals of albitic felspar, hornblende, and mica, a rock which has been considered as one of the varieties of andesite. Some tremendous earthquakes which have visited Peru in modern times will be mentioned in a subsequent chapter.

The space between Chile and Peru, where no volcanic activity has been observed, stretches 160 nautical leagues from south to north. However, as Von Buch points out, this area of the Andes is the least known, being sparsely populated and, in some regions, completely desert. The volcanoes in Peru rise from a high platform to impressive heights above sea level, ranging from 17,000 to 20,000 feet. The lava that has erupted from Viejo, at latitude 16° 55' S., accompanied by pumice, is made up of a blend of albitic feldspar, hornblende, and mica crystals, which is considered one of the types of andesite. Some significant earthquakes that have struck Peru in modern times will be discussed in a later chapter.

The volcanoes of Quito, occurring between the second degree of south and the third degree of north latitude, rise to vast elevations above the sea, many of them being between 14,000 and 18,000 feet high. The Indians of Lican have a tradition that the mountain called L'Altar, or Capac Urcu, which means "the chief," was once the highest of those near the equator, being higher than Chimborazo; but in the reign of Ouainia Abomatha, before the discovery of America, a prodigious eruption took place, which lasted eight years, and broke it down. The fragments of trachyte, says M. Boussingault, which once formed the conical summit of this celebrated mountain, are at this day spread over the plain.472 Cotopaxi is the most lofty of all the South American volcanoes which have been in a state of activity in modern times, its height being 18,858 feet; and its eruptions have been more frequent and destructive than those of any other mountain. It is a perfect cone, usually covered with an enormous bed of snow, which has, however, been sometimes melted suddenly during an eruption; as in January, 1803, for example, when the snows were dissolved in one night.

The volcanoes around Quito, located between the second degree of south and the third degree of north latitude, reach great heights above sea level, with many standing between 14,000 and 18,000 feet tall. The Lican Indians have a story that the mountain known as L'Altar, or Capac Urcu, meaning "the chief," was once the tallest in the region near the equator, even higher than Chimborazo. However, during the reign of Ouainia Abomatha, before America was discovered, a massive eruption occurred that lasted eight years and caused it to collapse. The pieces of trachyte that once made up the cone-shaped peak of this famous mountain are now scattered across the plain.472 Cotopaxi is the highest of all the active volcanoes in South America, standing at 18,858 feet. Its eruptions have been more frequent and more destructive than those of any other mountain. It has a perfect cone shape, usually covered with a thick layer of snow, which has occasionally melted quickly during an eruption; for instance, in January 1803, when the snow melted in just one night.

Deluges are often caused in the Andes by the liquefaction of great masses of snow, and sometimes by the rending open, during earthquakes, of subterranean cavities filled with water. In these inundations fine volcanic sand, loose stones, and other materials which the water meets with in its descent, are swept away, and a vast quantity of mud, called "moya," is thus formed and carried down into the lower regions. Mud derived from this source descended, in 1797, from the sides of Tunguragua in Quito, and filled valleys a thousand feet wide to the depth of six hundred feet, damming up rivers and causing lakes. In these currents and lakes of moya, thousands of small fish are sometimes enveloped, which, according to Humboldt, have lived and multiplied in subterranean cavities. So great a quantity of these fish were ejected from the volcano of Imbaburu in 1691, that fevers, which prevailed at the period, were attributed to the effluvia arising from the putrid animal matter.

Deluges in the Andes are often caused by the liquefaction of large masses of snow, and sometimes by the opening up of underground water-filled cavities during earthquakes. In these floods, fine volcanic sand, loose stones, and other materials that the water encounters on its way down are swept away, creating a massive amount of mud known as "moya," which is carried down to lower areas. In 1797, mud from this source flowed down from the sides of Tungurahua in Quito, filling valleys a thousand feet wide to a depth of six hundred feet, blocking rivers and forming lakes. Thousands of small fish are sometimes trapped in these moya currents and lakes, which, according to Humboldt, have lived and reproduced in underground cavities. A huge number of these fish were expelled from the volcano of Imbabura in 1691, leading to fevers at the time being attributed to the smells coming from the decaying fish matter.

In Quito, many important revolutions in the physical features of the country are said to have resulted, within the memory of man, from the earthquakes by which it has been convulsed. M. Boussingault declares his belief, that if a full register had been kept of all the convulsions experienced here and in other populous districts of the Andes, it would 349 be found that the trembling of the earth had been incessant. The frequency of the movement, he thinks, is not due to volcanic explosions, but to the continual falling in of masses of rock which have been fractured and upheaved in a solid form at a comparatively recent epoch; but a longer series of observations would be requisite to confirm this opinion. According to the same author, the height of several mountains of the Andes has diminished in modern times.473

In Quito, many significant changes in the country's physical features are said to have occurred, within living memory, due to the earthquakes that have struck the area. M. Boussingault believes that if a complete record had been kept of all the earthquakes experienced here and in other populated areas of the Andes, it would show that the earth has been shaking continuously. He thinks the frequency of these movements is not caused by volcanic eruptions, but rather by the constant collapse of rock masses that were fractured and raised in a solid state not too long ago; however, a longer period of observation would be needed to confirm this view. According to the same author, the heights of several Andes mountains have decreased in recent times.349473

The great crest or cordillera of the Andes is depressed at the Isthmus of Panama to a height of about 1000 feet, and at the lowest point of separation between the two seas near the Gulf of San Miguel, to 150 feet. What some geographers regard as a continuation of that chain in Central America lies to the east of a series of volcanoes, many of which are active in the provinces of Pasto, Popayan, and Guatemala. Coseguina, on the south side of the Gulf of Fonseca, was in eruption in January, 1835, and some of its ashes fell at Truxillo, on the shores of the Gulf of Mexico. What is still more remarkable, on the same day, at Kingston, in Jamaica, the same shower of ashes fell, having been carried by an upper counter-current against the regular east wind which was then blowing. Kingston is about 700 miles distant from Coseguina, and these ashes must have been more than four days in the air, having travelled 170 miles a day. Eight leagues to the southward of the crater, the ashes covered the ground to the depth of three yards and a half, destroying the woods and dwellings. Thousands of cattle perished, their bodies being in many instances one mass of scorched flesh. Deer and other wild animals sought the towns for protection; many birds and quadrupeds were found suffocated in the ashes, and the neighboring streams were strewed with dead fish.474 Such facts throw light on geological monuments, for in the ashes thrown out at remote periods from the volcanoes of Auvergne, now extinct, we find the bones and skeletons of lost species of quadrupeds.

The great mountain range or cordillera of the Andes sinks down at the Isthmus of Panama to about 1,000 feet, and at the lowest point separating the two seas near the Gulf of San Miguel, it drops to 150 feet. What some geographers see as a continuation of that chain in Central America is located east of a series of volcanoes, many of which are active in the provinces of Pasto, Popayán, and Guatemala. Coseguina, on the south side of the Gulf of Fonseca, erupted in January 1835, and some of its ashes fell at Truxillo, on the shores of the Gulf of Mexico. Even more astonishing, on the same day, a similar shower of ashes fell in Kingston, Jamaica, having been carried by an upper counter-current against the regular east wind that was blowing at the time. Kingston is about 700 miles away from Coseguina, and these ashes must have been airborne for more than four days, traveling about 170 miles a day. Eight leagues south of the crater, the ashes covered the ground to a depth of three and a half yards, destroying the forests and homes. Thousands of cattle died, their bodies often reduced to a mass of scorched flesh. Deer and other wild animals sought refuge in towns; many birds and mammals were found suffocated in the ashes, and the nearby streams were littered with dead fish.474 Such events shed light on geological records, for in the ashes ejected from the now-extinct volcanoes of Auvergne, we discover the bones and skeletons of lost species of mammals.

Mexico.—The great volcanic chain, after having thus pursued its course for several thousand miles from south to north, sends off a branch in a new direction in Mexico, in the parallel of the city of that name, and is prolonged in a great platform between the eighteenth and twenty-second degrees of north latitude. Five active volcanoes traverse Mexico from west to east—Tu`xtla, Orizaba, Popocatepetl, Jorullo, and Colima. Jorullo, which is in the centre of the great platform, is no less than 120 miles from the nearest ocean—an important circumstance, as showing that the proximity of the sea is not a necessary condition, although certainly a very general characteristic of the position of active volcanoes. The extraordinary eruption of this mountain, in 1759, will be described in the sequel. If the line which connects these five vents be prolonged in a westerly direction, it cuts the volcanic group of islands called the Isles of Revillagigedo.

Mexico.—The vast volcanic chain, after traveling several thousand miles from south to north, branches off in a new direction in Mexico, near the city of the same name, and extends across a large platform between the eighteenth and twenty-second degrees of north latitude. Five active volcanoes stretch across Mexico from west to east—Tuxtla, Orizaba, Popocatepetl, Jorullo, and Colima. Jorullo, located in the center of this large platform, is 120 miles away from the nearest ocean—an important point that shows the sea's proximity isn't a necessary condition, even though it’s a common feature for active volcanoes. The remarkable eruption of this mountain in 1759 will be discussed later. If you extend the line connecting these five volcanoes westward, it intersects the volcanic island group known as the Isles of Revillagigedo.

350 To the north of Mexico there are said to be three, or according to some, five volcanoes in the peninsula of California; and a volcano is reported to have been in eruption in the N. W. coast of America, near the Colombia river, lat. 45° 37' N.

350 To the north of Mexico, there are said to be three, or according to some, five volcanoes in the California peninsula; and it’s reported that a volcano has erupted on the north-west coast of America, near the Columbia River, lat. 45° 37' N.

West Indies.—To return to the Andes of Quito: Von Buch inclines to the belief that if we were better acquainted with the region to the east of the Madalena, and with New Granada and the Caraccas, we might find the volcanic chain of the Andes to be connected with that of the West Indian or Carribee Islands. The truth of this conjecture has almost been set at rest by the eruption, in 1848, of the volcano of Zamba, in New Grenada, at the mouth of the river Madalena.475

West Indies.—Returning to the Andes of Quito: Von Buch believes that if we knew more about the area east of the Madalena, as well as New Granada and the Caraccas, we might discover that the volcanic chain of the Andes is linked to that of the West Indian or Caribbean Islands. The validity of this idea has nearly been confirmed by the eruption in 1848 of the Zamba volcano in New Granada, at the mouth of the Madalena River.475

Of the West Indian islands there are two parallel series: the one to the west, which are all volcanic, and which rise to the height of several thousand feet; the others to the east, for the most part composed of calcareous rocks, and very low. In the former or volcanic series, are Granada, St. Vincent, St. Lucia, Martinique, Dominica, Guadaloupe, Montserrat, Nevis, and St. Eustace. In the calcareous chain are Tobago, Barbadoes, Mariegallante, Grandeterre, Desirade, Antigua, Barbuda, St. Bartholomew, and St. Martin. The most considerable eruptions in modern times have been those of St. Vincent. Great earthquakes have agitated St. Domingo, as will be seen in the twenty-ninth chapter.

Of the West Indian islands, there are two parallel groups: the ones to the west, which are all volcanic and rise several thousand feet high; and the ones to the east, mostly made up of limestone and quite low. In the volcanic group, you'll find Grenada, St. Vincent, St. Lucia, Martinique, Dominica, Guadeloupe, Montserrat, Nevis, and St. Eustatius. In the limestone group are Tobago, Barbados, Marie-Galante, Grande Terre, Désirade, Antigua, Barbuda, St. Barthélemy, and St. Martin. The most significant eruptions in recent times have been those of St. Vincent. Major earthquakes have shaken St. Domingo, as will be discussed in chapter twenty-nine.

I have before mentioned (p. 270) the violent earthquake which in 1812 convulsed the valley of the Mississippi at New Madrid, for the space of 300 miles in length, of which more will be said in the twenty-seventh chapter. This happened exactly at the same time as the great earthquake of Caraccas, so that it is possible that these two points are parts of one subterranean volcanic region. The island of Jamaica, with a tract of the contiguous sea, has often experienced tremendous shocks; and these are frequent along a line extending from Jamaica to St. Domingo and Porto Rico.

I previously mentioned (p. 270) the massive earthquake that shook the Mississippi Valley at New Madrid in 1812, which stretched 300 miles. More details will be provided in the twenty-seventh chapter. This occurred at the same time as the major earthquake in Caracas, so it's possible that these two locations are part of the same underground volcanic zone. The island of Jamaica and the surrounding sea have frequently experienced powerful shocks, especially along a line that runs from Jamaica to Hispaniola and Puerto Rico.

Thus it will be seen that, without taking account of the West Indian and Mexican branches, a linear train of volcanoes and tracts shaken by earthquakes may be traced from the island of Chiloe and opposite coast to Mexico, or even perhaps to the mouth of the Colombia river—a distance upon the whole as great as from the pole to the equator. In regard to the western limits of the region, they lie deep beneath the waves of the Pacific, and must continue unknown to us. On the east they are not prolonged, except where they include the West Indian Islands, to a great distance; for there seem to be no indications of volcanic disturbances in Buenos Ayres, Brazil, and the United States of North America.

Thus, it can be seen that, without considering the West Indian and Mexican branches, there is a continuous line of volcanoes and areas affected by earthquakes stretching from the island of Chiloe and the opposite coast to Mexico, or maybe even to the mouth of the Colombia river—a distance roughly as large as from the North Pole to the equator. Regarding the western boundaries of the region, they lie deep beneath the Pacific waves and are still unknown to us. To the east, they don’t extend far, except where they include the West Indian Islands; there are no signs of volcanic activity in Buenos Aires, Brazil, and the United States.

Fig. 39.

Fig. 39.

MAP OF ACTIVE VOLCANOES AND ATOLLS of The Indian Archipelago

MAP OF ACTIVE VOLCANOES AND ATOLLS of The Indian Archipelago, and Part of the adjoining Pacific Ocean.

MAP OF ACTIVE VOLCANOES AND ATOLLS of The Indian Archipelago, and Part of the adjoining Pacific Ocean.

Volcanic region from the Aleutian Isles to the Moluccas and Isles of Sunda.—On a scale which equals or surpasses that of the Andes, is another line of volcanic action, which commences, on the north, with the Aleutian Isles in Russian America, and extends, first in a westerly 352 direction for nearly 200 geographical miles, and then southwards, with few interruptions, throughout a space of between sixty and seventy degrees of latitude to the Moluccas, where it sends off a branch to the southeast while the principal train continues westerly through Sumbawa and Java to Sumatra, and then in a northwesterly direction to the Bay of Bengal.476 This volcanic line, observes Von Buch, may be said to follow throughout its course the external border of the continent of Asia; while the branch which has been alluded to as striking southeast from the Moluccas, passes from New Guinea to New Zealand, conforming, though somewhat rudely, to the outline of Australia.477

Volcanic region from the Aleutian Isles to the Moluccas and Isles of Sunda.—There is a line of volcanic activity that matches or exceeds that of the Andes, starting in the north with the Aleutian Isles in Russian America. It stretches first westward for nearly 200 geographical miles and then continues southward, with few stops, over a range of about sixty to seventy degrees of latitude to the Moluccas. Here, it sends off a branch to the southeast while the main line heads westward through Sumbawa and Java to Sumatra, then takes a northwestern route to the Bay of Bengal.476 This volcanic line, noted by Von Buch, seems to trace the outer edge of the continent of Asia; the southeastern branch from the Moluccas extends from New Guinea to New Zealand, roughly following the shape of Australia.477

The connection, however, of the New Guinea volcanoes with the line in Java (as laid down in Von Buch's map) is not clearly made out. By consulting Darwin's map of coral reefs and active volcanoes,478 the reader will see that we might almost with equal propriety include the Mariana and Bonin volcanoes in a band with New Guinea. Or if we allow so much latitude in framing zones of volcanic action, we must also suppose the New Hebrides, Solomon Isles, and New Ireland to constitute one line (see map, fig. 39, p. 351).

The link between the New Guinea volcanoes and the line in Java (as shown in Von Buch's map) isn't very clear. By looking at Darwin's map of coral reefs and active volcanoes,478 you'll notice that we could almost justifiably include the Mariana and Bonin volcanoes in a similar line with New Guinea. Or if we allow for that kind of flexibility in defining zones of volcanic activity, we should also consider the New Hebrides, Solomon Islands, and New Ireland to be part of one line (see map, fig. 39, p. 351).

The northern extremity of the volcanic region of Asia, as described by Von Buch, is on the borders of Cook's Inlet, northeast of the Peninsula of Alaska, where one volcano, in about the sixtieth degree of latitude, is said to be 14,000 feet high. In Alaska itself are cones of vast height, which have been seen in eruption, and which are covered for two-thirds of their height downwards with perpetual snow. The summit of the loftiest peak is truncated, and is said to have fallen in during an eruption in 1786. From Alaska the line is continued through the Aleutian or Fox Islands to Kamtschatka. In the Aleutian Archipelago eruptions are frequent, and about thirty miles to the north of Unalaska, near the Isle of Umnack, a new island was formed in 1796. It was first observed after a storm, at a point in the sea from which a column of smoke had been seen to rise. Flames then issued from the new islet which illuminated the country for ten miles round; a frightful earthquake shook the new-formed cone, and showers of stones were thrown as far as Umnack. The eruption continued for several months, and eight years afterwards, in 1804, when it was explored by some hunters, the soil was so hot in some places that they could not walk on it. According to Langsdorf and others, this new island, which is now several thousand feet high, and two or three miles in circumference, has been continually found to have increased in size when successively visited by different travellers; but we have no accurate means of determining how much of its growth, if any, has been due to upheaval, or how far it has been exclusively formed by the ejection of ashes and streams of lava. It seems, however, to be well attested that earthquakes of the most 353 terrific description agitate and alter the bed of the sea and surface of the land throughout this tract.

The northern edge of Asia's volcanic region, as noted by Von Buch, is located at the borders of Cook's Inlet, northeast of the Alaska Peninsula, where one volcano, around the sixtieth parallel, is said to rise 14,000 feet high. In Alaska itself, there are towering cones that have been observed erupting and are covered with permanent snow for two-thirds of their height. The top of the tallest peak is flattened, which supposedly collapsed during an eruption in 1786. From Alaska, the volcanic line extends through the Aleutian or Fox Islands to Kamchatka. Eruptions are common in the Aleutian Archipelago, and about thirty miles north of Unalaska, near Umnack Island, a new island emerged in 1796. It was first spotted after a storm in an area of the sea where a column of smoke was seen rising. Flames then erupted from the new island, illuminating the surrounding area for ten miles; a powerful earthquake shook the newly formed cone, and showers of stones were launched as far as Umnack. The eruption lasted several months, and eight years later, in 1804, when hunters explored it, some areas of the soil were too hot to walk on. According to Langsdorf and others, this new island, now several thousand feet high and two to three miles around, has notably grown in size during visits by various travelers; however, we have no reliable way to determine how much of its growth is due to uplift versus how much was formed solely from the ejection of ash and lava. It does seem well documented that exceptionally powerful earthquakes shake and change the seabed and land surface across this area.

The line is continued in the southern extremity of the Peninsula of Kamtschatka, where there are many active volcanoes, which, in some eruptions, have scattered ashes to immense distances. The largest and most active of these is Klutschew, lat. 56° 3' N., which rises at once from the sea to the prodigious height of 15,000 feet. Within 700 feet of the summit, Erman saw, in 1829, a current of lava, emitting a vivid light, flow down the northwest side to the foot of the cone. A flow of lava from the summit of Mont Blanc to its base in the valley of Chamouni would afford but an inadequate idea of the declivity down which this current descended. Large quantities of ice and snow opposed for a time a barrier to the lava, until at length the fiery torrent overcame, by its heat and pressure, this obstacle, and poured down the mountain side with a frightful noise, which was heard for a distance of more than fifty miles.479

The line continues at the southern end of the Kamchatka Peninsula, where there are many active volcanoes that, during certain eruptions, have spread ashes over vast distances. The largest and most active of these is Klutchev, located at 56° 3' N. It rises dramatically from the sea to an impressive height of 15,000 feet. Erman observed, in 1829, a flow of lava glowing brightly just 700 feet below the summit, streaming down the northwest side to the base of the cone. A lava flow from the top of Mont Blanc to its base in the Chamouni valley would barely give an idea of the steepness of this flow's descent. Large amounts of ice and snow temporarily blocked the lava until, eventually, the intense heat and pressure allowed the molten rock to break through, rushing down the mountainside with a terrifying noise that could be heard for over fifty miles.479

The Kurile chain of islands constitutes the prolongation of the Kamtschatka range, where a train of volcanic mountains, nine of which are known to have been in eruption, trends in a southerly direction. The line is then continued to the southwest in the great island of Jesso, and again in Nipon, the principal of the Japanese group. It then extends by Loo Choo and Formosa to the Philippine Islands, and thence by Sangir and the northeastern extremity of Celebes to the Moluccas (see map, fig. 39). Afterwards it passes westward through Sumbawa to Java.

The Kurile chain of islands is an extension of the Kamchatka range, where a series of volcanic mountains, nine of which are known to have erupted, runs southward. This line continues southwest to the large island of Jesso, and then to Nipon, the main island of the Japanese group. It further extends through Loo Choo and Formosa to the Philippine Islands, and from there goes to Sangir and the northeastern tip of Celebes, reaching the Moluccas (see map, fig. 39). After that, it moves west through Sumbawa to Java.

There are said to be thirty-eight considerable volcanoes in Java, some of which are more than 10,000 feet high. They are remarkable for the quantity of sulphur and sulphureous vapors which they discharge. They rarely emit lava, but rivers of mud issue from them, like the moya of the Andes of Quito. The memorable eruption of Galongoon, in 1822, will be described in the twenty-fifth chapter. The crater of Taschem, at the eastern extremity of Java, contains a lake strongly impregnated with sulphuric acid, a quarter of a mile long, from which a river of acid water issues, which supports no living creature, nor can fish live in the sea near its confluence. There is an extinct crater near Batur, called Guevo Upas, or the Valley of Poison, about half a mile in circumference, which is justly an object of terror to the inhabitants of the country. Every living being which penetrates into this valley falls down dead, and the soil is covered with the carcasses of tigers, deer, birds, and even the bones of men; all killed by the abundant emanations of carbonic acid gas, by which the bottom of the valley is filled.

There are said to be thirty-eight significant volcanoes in Java, some over 10,000 feet tall. They're noted for the amount of sulfur and sulfurous gases they release. They rarely produce lava, but rivers of mud flow from them, similar to the moya in the Andes of Quito. The notable eruption of Galongoon in 1822 will be discussed in the twenty-fifth chapter. The crater of Taschem, located at the eastern end of Java, has a lake heavily infused with sulfuric acid, stretching a quarter of a mile long, from which an acidic river flows. This river cannot support any life, and fish cannot survive in the sea near its confluence. There’s an extinct crater near Batur called Guevo Upas, or the Valley of Poison, which is about half a mile around and rightly instills fear in the local people. Any living being that enters this valley drops dead, and the ground is littered with the remains of tigers, deer, birds, and even human bones, all killed by the abundant emissions of carbonic acid gas that fill the bottom of the valley.

In another crater in this land of wonders, near the volcano of Talaga Bodas, we learn from M. Reinwardt, that the sulphureous exhalations have killed tigers, birds, and innumerable insects; and the soft parts of these animals, such as as the fibres, muscles, nails, hair, and skin, are 354 very well preserved, while the bones are corroded, and entirely destroyed.

In another crater in this amazing land, close to the Talaga Bodas volcano, we find out from M. Reinwardt that the sulfurous fumes have killed tigers, birds, and countless insects; and the softer parts of these animals, like the fibers, muscles, nails, hair, and skin, are 354 well preserved, while the bones are eaten away and completely gone.

We learn from observations made in 1844, by Mr. Jukes, that a recent tertiary formation composed of limestone and resembling the coral rock of a fringing reef, clings to the flanks of all the volcanic islands from the east end of Timor to the west end of Java. These modern calcareous strata are often white and chalk-like, sometimes 1000 feet and upwards above the sea, regularly stratified in thick horizontal beds, and they show that there has been a general elevation of these islands at a comparatively modern period.480

We learn from observations made in 1844 by Mr. Jukes that a recent layer of rock made up of limestone and similar to the coral found in a fringing reef clings to the sides of all the volcanic islands from the east end of Timor to the west end of Java. These modern limestone layers are often white and chalky, sometimes rising 1,000 feet or more above sea level, laid out in thick, horizontal beds, indicating that there has been a general rise in these islands in relatively recent times.480

The same linear arrangement which is observed in Java holds good in the volcanoes of Sumatra, some of which are of great height, as Berapi, which is more than 12,000 feet above the sea, and is continually smoking. Hot springs are abundant at its base. The volcanic line then inclines slightly to the northwest, and points to Barren Island, lat. 12° 15´ N., in the Bay of Bengal. This volcano was in eruption in 1792, and will be described in the twenty-sixth chapter. The volcanic train then extends, according to Dr. Macclelland, to the island of Narcondam, lat. 13° 22´ N., which is a cone seven or eight hundred feet high, rising from deep water, and said to present signs of lava currents descending from the crater to the base. Afterwards the train stretches in the same direction to the volcanic island of Ramree, about lat. 19° N., and the adjoining island of Cheduba, which is represented in old charts as a burning mountain. Thus we arrive at the Chittagong coast, which in 1762 was convulsed by a tremendous earthquake (see chap. 29).481

The same linear layout seen in Java is also present in the volcanoes of Sumatra, some of which are quite tall, like Berapi, which is over 12,000 feet above sea level and constantly emits smoke. There are many hot springs at its base. The volcanic line then tilts slightly northwest, pointing toward Barren Island, located at lat. 12° 15’ N. in the Bay of Bengal. This volcano erupted in 1792 and will be discussed in the twenty-sixth chapter. According to Dr. Macclelland, the volcanic chain extends to the island of Narcondam, at lat. 13° 22’ N, which is a cone-shaped volcano seven or eight hundred feet high, rising from deep water, and is said to show signs of lava flows moving down from the crater to the base. Then, the chain continues in the same direction to the volcanic island of Ramree, around lat. 19° N, and the nearby island of Cheduba, which is depicted in old maps as a burning mountain. This leads us to the Chittagong coast, which experienced a massive earthquake in 1762 (see chap. 29).481

To enumerate all the volcanic regions of the Indian and Pacific oceans would lead me far beyond the proper limits of this treatise; but it will appear in the last chapter of this volume, when coral reefs are treated of, that the islands of the Pacific consist alternately of linear groups of two classes, the one lofty, and containing active volcanoes, and marine strata above the sea-level, and which have been undergoing upheaval in modern times; the other very low, consisting of reefs of coral, usually with lagoons in their centres, and in which there is evidence of a gradual subsidence of the ground. The extent and direction of these parallel volcanic bands have been depicted with great care by Darwin in his map before cited (p. 351).

To list all the volcanic regions of the Indian and Pacific oceans would take me far beyond the appropriate scope of this work; however, it will be discussed in the last chapter of this volume, which focuses on coral reefs. The islands of the Pacific are made up of alternating linear groups of two types: one type is high and has active volcanoes and marine layers above sea level, which have been rising in recent times; the other type is very low and consists of coral reefs, usually with lagoons in the center, showing signs of gradual sinking of the ground. The extent and alignment of these parallel volcanic belts have been carefully illustrated by Darwin in the previously referenced map (p. 351).

The most remarkable theatre of volcanic activity in the Northern Pacific—or, perhaps, in the whole world—occurs in the Sandwich Islands, which have been admirably treated of in a recent work by Mr. Dana.482

The most impressive volcanic activity in the Northern Pacific—or maybe in the entire world—happens in the Sandwich Islands, which have been excellently discussed in a recent book by Mr. Dana.482

Volcanic region from central Asia to the Azores.—Another great region of subterranean disturbance is that which has been imagined to extend through a large part of Central Asia to the Azores, that is to 355 say, from China and Tartary through Lake Aral and the Caspian to the Caucasus, and the countries bordering the Black Sea, then again through part of Asia Minor to Syria, and westward to the Grecian Islands, Greece, Naples, Sicily, the southern part of Spain, Portugal and the Azores. Respecting the eastern extremity of this line in China, we have little information, but many violent earthquakes are known to have occurred there. The volcano said to have been in eruption in the seventh century in Central Tartary is situated on the northern declivity of the Celestial Mountains, not far distant from the large lake called Issikoul; and Humboldt mentions other vents and solfataras in the same quarter, which are all worthy of notice, as being far more distant from the ocean (260 geographical miles) than any other known points of eruption.

Volcanic region from central Asia to the Azores.—Another major area of underground activity is believed to stretch across a significant part of Central Asia to the Azores, which means from China and Tartary through Lake Aral and the Caspian Sea to the Caucasus, and the countries around the Black Sea, then again through part of Asia Minor to Syria, and westward to the Greek Islands, Greece, Naples, Sicily, the southern part of Spain, Portugal, and the Azores. Regarding the eastern end of this line in China, we have limited information, but numerous strong earthquakes are known to have occurred there. The volcano that is said to have erupted in the seventh century in Central Tartary is located on the northern slope of the Celestial Mountains, not far from the large lake called Issikoul; and Humboldt notes other vents and solfataras in the same area, all of which are noteworthy because they are considerably farther from the ocean (260 geographical miles) than any other known eruption sites.

We find on the western shores of the Caspian, in the country round Baku, a tract called the Field of Fire, which continually emits inflammable gas, while springs of naphtha and petroleum occur in the same vicinity, as also mud volcanoes. Syria and Palestine abound in volcanic appearances, and very extensive areas have been shaken, at different periods, with great destruction of cities and loss of lives. Continual mention is made in history of the ravages committed by earthquakes in Sidon, Tyre, Berytus, Laodicea, and Antioch, and in the Island of Cyprus. The country around the Dead Sea appears evidently, from the accounts of modern travellers, to be volcanic. A district near Smyrna, in Asia Minor, was termed by the Greeks Catacecaumene, or "the burnt up," where there is a large arid territory, without trees, and with a cindery soil.483 This country was visited in 1841 by Mr. W. J. Hamilton, who found in the valley of the Hermus perfect cones of scoriæ, with lava-streams, like those of Auvergne, conforming to the existing river-channels, and with their surface undecomposed.484

We find on the western shores of the Caspian, in the area around Baku, a region called the Field of Fire, which constantly releases flammable gas. Nearby, there are also springs of naphtha and petroleum, along with mud volcanoes. Syria and Palestine are full of volcanic features, and large areas have been shaken at different times, resulting in significant destruction of cities and loss of lives. History frequently mentions the devastation caused by earthquakes in Sidon, Tyre, Berytus, Laodicea, and Antioch, as well as in the Island of Cyprus. The area around the Dead Sea appears to be volcanic, according to accounts from modern travelers. A region near Smyrna in Asia Minor was referred to by the Greeks as Catacecaumene, meaning "the burnt up," where there is a large arid area with no trees and a cindery soil.483 This country was visited in 1841 by Mr. W. J. Hamilton, who discovered perfect cones of scoria in the valley of the Hermus, with lava streams similar to those in Auvergne, following the contours of existing river channels, and their surfaces remained undecomposed.484

Grecian Archipelago.—Proceeding westwards, we reach the Grecian Archipelago, where Santorin, afterwards to be described, is the grand centre of volcanic action.

Greek Archipelago.—Heading west, we arrive at the Greek Archipelago, where Santorini, which will be described later, is the main hub of volcanic activity.

It was Von Buch's opinion that the volcanoes of Greece were arranged in a line running N. N. W. and S. S. E., and that they afforded the only example in Europe of active volcanoes having a linear direction; but M. Virlet, on the contrary, announces as the result of his investigations, made during the French expedition to the Morea in 1829, that there is no one determinate line of direction for the volcanic phenomena in Greece, whether we follow the points of eruptions, or the earthquakes, or any other signs of igneous agency.485

Von Buch believed that the volcanoes in Greece were aligned in a line running N.N.W. and S.S.E., making them the only example of active volcanoes in Europe with a linear arrangement. However, M. Virlet, based on his research during the French expedition to the Morea in 1829, argues that there is no single clear line of direction for volcanic activity in Greece, whether we look at eruption points, earthquakes, or any other signs of volcanic activity.485

Macedonia, Thrace, and Epirus, have always been subject to earthquakes, and the Ionian Isles are continually convulsed.

Macedonia, Thrace, and Epirus have always experienced earthquakes, and the Ionian Islands are constantly shaken.

Respecting Southern Italy, Sicily, and the Lipari Isles, it is unnecessary to enlarge here, as I shall have occasion again to allude to them. 356 I may mention, however, that a band of volcanic action has been traced by Dr. Daubeny across the Italian Peninsula, from Ischia to Mount Vultur, in Apulia, the commencement of the line being found in the hot springs of Ischia, after which it is prolonged through Vesuvius to the Lago d'Ansanto, where gases similar to those of Vesuvius are evolved. Its farther extension strikes Mount Vultur, a lofty cone composed of tuff and lava, from one side of which carbonic acid and sulphuretted hydrogen are emitted.486

Regarding Southern Italy, Sicily, and the Lipari Islands, it’s unnecessary to elaborate here, as I will refer to them again later. 356 I can mention, though, that Dr. Daubeny has traced a volcanic action line across the Italian Peninsula, from Ischia to Mount Vultur in Apulia. The line starts at the hot springs of Ischia and continues through Vesuvius to Lago d'Ansanto, where gases similar to those from Vesuvius are released. Its further extension reaches Mount Vultur, a tall cone made of tuff and lava, from which carbonic acid and hydrogen sulfide are emitted.486

Traditions of deluges.—The traditions which have come down to us from remote ages of great inundations said to have happened in Greece and on the confines of the Grecian settlements, had doubtless their origin in a series of local catastrophes, caused principally by earthquakes. The frequent migrations of the earlier inhabitants, and the total want of written annals long after the first settlement of each country, make it impossible for us at this distance of time to fix either the true localities or probable dates of these events. The first philosophical writers of Greece were, therefore, as much at a loss as ourselves to offer a reasonable conjecture on these points, or to decide how many catastrophes might sometimes have become confounded in one tale, or how much this tale may have been amplified, in after times, or obscured by mythological fiction. The floods of Ogyges and Deucalion are commonly said to have happened before the Trojan war; that of Ogyges more than seventeen, and that of Deucalion more than fifteen centuries before our era. As to the Ogygian flood, it is generally described as having laid waste Attica, and was referred by some writers to a great overflowing of rivers, to which cause Aristotle also attributed the deluge of Deucalion, which, he says, affected Hellas only, or the central part of Thessaly. Others imagined the same event to have been due to an earthquake, which drew down masses of rock, and stopped up the course of the Peneus in the narrow defile between mounts Ossa and Olympus.

Traditions of floods.—The stories that have been passed down to us from ancient times about major floods said to have occurred in Greece and its neighboring regions likely stem from a series of local disasters, primarily caused by earthquakes. The frequent migrations of the early inhabitants, along with the complete lack of written records long after the initial settlements, make it impossible for us to accurately identify the actual locations or likely dates of these events. The first philosophical writers of Greece were just as confused as we are in trying to propose reasonable theories on these matters or to determine how many disasters might have been mixed together in a single story, or how much these stories may have been exaggerated or obscured by mythical elements over time. The floods of Ogyges and Deucalion are commonly said to have happened before the Trojan War; the flood of Ogyges more than seventeen centuries ago, and that of Deucalion more than fifteen centuries before our era. Regarding the Ogygian flood, it is generally described as having devastated Attica, and some writers attributed it to a major overflow of rivers, a cause Aristotle also linked to the flood of Deucalion, which he says affected Greece only, or the central region of Thessaly. Others believed the same event was caused by an earthquake that caused massive rockslides, blocking the flow of the Peneus in the narrow gorge between Mounts Ossa and Olympus.

As to the deluge of Samothrace, which is generally referred to a distinct date, it appears that the shores of that small island and the adjoining mainland of Asia were inundated by the sea. Diodorus Siculus says that the inhabitants had time to take refuge in the mountains, and save themselves by flight; he also relates, that long after the event the fishermen of the island drew up in their nets the capitals of columns, which were the remains of cities submerged by that terrible catastrophe.487 These statements scarcely leave any doubt that there occurred, at the period alluded to, a subsidence of the coast, accompanied by earthquakes and inroads of the sea. It is not impossible that the story of the bursting of the Black Sea through the Thracian Bosphorus into the Grecian Archipelago, which accompanied, and, as some say, caused the Samothracian deluge, may have reference to a wave, or succession of waves, raised in the Euxine by the same convulsion.

As for the flood of Samothrace, which is usually linked to a specific date, it seems that the shores of that small island and the nearby mainland of Asia were flooded by the sea. Diodorus Siculus mentions that the locals had time to escape to the mountains and save themselves by fleeing; he also notes that long after the event, fishermen from the island pulled up the capitals of columns in their nets, which were remnants of cities submerged by that terrible disaster.487 These accounts leave little doubt that during the time mentioned, there was a sinking of the coast, accompanied by earthquakes and encroachments of the sea. It's also possible that the story of the Black Sea breaking through the Thracian Bosphorus into the Greek Archipelago, which some say led to the flood in Samothrace, refers to a wave or series of waves caused by the same upheaval.

357 We know that subterranean movements and volcanic eruptions are often attended not only by incursions of the sea, but also by violent rains, and the complete derangement of the river drainage of the inland country, and by the damming up of the outlets of lakes by landslips, or obstructions in the courses of subterranean rivers, such as abound in Thessaly and the Morea. We need not therefore be surprised at the variety of causes assigned for the traditional floods of Greece, by Herodotus, Aristotle, Diodorus, Strabo, and others. As to the area embraced, had all the Grecian deluges occurred simultaneously, instead of being spread over many centuries, and had they, instead of being extremely local, reached at once from the Euxine to the southwestern limit of the Peloponnese, and from Macedonia to Rhodes, the devastation would still have been more limited than that which visited Chili in 1835, when a volcanic eruption broke out in the Andes, opposite Chiloe, and another at Juan Fernandez, distant 720 geographical miles, at the same time that several lofty cones, in the Cordillera, 400 miles to the eastward of that island, threw out vapor and ignited matter. Throughout a great part of the space thus recently shaken in South America, cities were laid in ruins, or the land was permanently upheaved, or mountainous waves rolled inland from the Pacific.

357 We know that underground movements and volcanic eruptions are often accompanied not only by sea invasions but also by severe rain, complete disruption of river systems in inland areas, and blockages of lake outlets due to landslides or obstacles in the paths of underground rivers, which are common in Thessaly and the Morea. Therefore, we shouldn’t be surprised by the different explanations given for the legendary floods of Greece by Herodotus, Aristotle, Diodorus, Strabo, and others. Regarding the areas affected, if all the floods in Greece had happened at the same time, instead of over many centuries, and if they had covered a wide area from the Black Sea to the southwestern tip of the Peloponnese, and from Macedonia to Rhodes, the destruction would still have been less severe than what struck Chile in 1835, when a volcanic eruption occurred in the Andes, near Chiloe, and another at Juan Fernandez, 720 nautical miles away, while several tall volcanoes in the Cordillera, 400 miles east of that island, erupted with vapor and fiery debris. Throughout much of the region recently shaken in South America, cities were destroyed, land was permanently lifted, and huge waves surged inland from the Pacific.

Periodical alternation of Earthquakes in Syria and Southern Italy.—It has been remarked by Von Hoff, that from the commencement of the thirteenth to the latter half of the seventeenth century, there was an almost entire cessation of earthquakes in Syria and Judea; and, during this interval of quiescence, the Archipelago, together with part of the adjacent coast of Lesser Asia, as also Southern Italy and Sicily, suffered greatly from earthquakes; while volcanic eruptions were unusually frequent in the same regions. A more extended comparison, also, of the history of the subterranean convulsions of these tracts seems to confirm the opinion, that a violent crisis of commotion never visits both at the same time. It is impossible for us to declare, as yet, whether this phenomenon is constant in this and other regions, because we can rarely trace back a connected series of events farther than a few centuries; but it is well known that, where numerous vents are clustered together within a small area, as in many archipelagoes for instance, two of them are never in violent eruption at once. If the action of one becomes very great for a century or more, the others assume the appearance of spent volcanoes. It is, therefore, not improbable that separate provinces of the same great range of volcanic fires may hold a relation to one deep-seated focus, analogous to that which the apertures of a small group bear to some more superficial rent or cavity. Thus, for example, we may conjecture that, at a comparatively small distance from the surface, Ischia and Vesuvius mutually communicate with certain fissures, and that each affords relief alternately to elastic fluids and lava there generated. So we may suppose Southern Italy and Syria to be connected, at a much greater depth, with a lower part of the very same system of fissures; in which case any obstruction occurring in one duct may have 358 the effect of causing almost all the vapor and melted matter to be forced up the other, and if they cannot get vent, they may be the cause of violent earthquakes. Some objections advanced against this doctrine that "volcanoes act as safety-valves," will be considered in the sequel.488

Periodic Alternation of Earthquakes in Syria and Southern Italy.—Von Hoff noted that from the start of the thirteenth century to the latter half of the seventeenth century, earthquakes in Syria and Judea almost completely stopped. During this calm period, the Archipelago, parts of the nearby coast of Lesser Asia, as well as Southern Italy and Sicily, experienced significant earthquakes, while volcanic eruptions were unusually common in those areas. A broader comparison of the seismic history in these regions suggests that violent disruptions rarely happen simultaneously. It's hard to determine whether this pattern is consistent across this and other regions because we can usually only trace a continuous series of events back a few centuries. However, it’s well-known that where many vents are clustered closely together, like in some archipelagos, two volcanoes don’t erupt violently at the same time. If one becomes very active for a century or more, the others appear to be dormant. Therefore, it’s likely that different areas of the same large volcanic range are connected to one deep-seated focus, similar to how the vents of a small group relate to a more superficial crack or cavity. For instance, we might speculate that Ischia and Vesuvius communicate with certain fissures below the surface, allowing them to alternately release gases and lava. In this way, Southern Italy and Syria could be linked at a much greater depth to a lower part of the same system of fissures; in which case, if there’s a blockage in one duct, it could force nearly all the vapor and molten material up the other duct. If they can't escape, this could lead to severe earthquakes. Some objections to the idea that "volcanoes act as safety valves" will be addressed later.358

The northeastern portion of Africa, including Egypt, which lies six or seven degrees south of the volcanic line already traced, has been almost always exempt from earthquakes; but the northwestern portion, especially Fez and Morocco, which fall within the line, suffer greatly from time to time. The southern part of Spain also, and Portugal, have generally been exposed to the same scourge simultaneously with Northern Africa. The provinces of Malaga, Murcia, and Granada, and in Portugal the country round Lisbon, are recorded at several periods to have been devastated by great earthquakes. It will be seen, from Michell's account of the great Lisbon shock, in 1755, that the first movement proceeded from the bed of the ocean ten or fifteen leagues from the coast. So late as February 2, 1816, when Lisbon was vehemently shaken, two ships felt a shock in the ocean west from Lisbon; one of them at the distance of 120, and the other 262 French leagues from the coast489—a fact which is more interesting, because a line drawn through the Grecian Archipelago, the volcanic region of Southern Italy, Sicily, Southern Spain, and Portugal, will, if prolonged westward through the ocean, strike the volcanic group of the Azores, which may possibly therefore have a submarine connection with the European line.

The northeastern part of Africa, including Egypt, which is positioned six or seven degrees south of the volcanic line already mentioned, has generally been free from earthquakes. However, the northwestern area, particularly Fez and Morocco, that falls within this line, frequently experiences significant tremors. The southern regions of Spain and Portugal have also faced the same issue concurrently with Northern Africa. The provinces of Malaga, Murcia, and Granada, along with the area around Lisbon in Portugal, have been recorded at various times as being severely affected by major earthquakes. From Michell’s account of the significant Lisbon earthquake in 1755, it’s noted that the initial movement originated from the ocean floor, about ten to fifteen leagues off the coast. As recently as February 2, 1816, when Lisbon was violently shaken, two ships in the ocean west of Lisbon felt a shock; one was 120 leagues away, and the other was 262 French leagues from the coast489—which is particularly fascinating because a line drawn through the Greek Archipelago, the volcanic region of Southern Italy, Sicily, Southern Spain, and Portugal, if extended westward through the ocean, would intersect the volcanic group of the Azores, suggesting a possible underwater connection with the European line.

In regard to the volcanic system of Southern Europe, it may be observed, that there is a central tract where the greatest earthquakes prevail, in which rocks are shattered, mountains rent, the surface elevated or depressed, and cities laid in ruins. On each side of this line of greatest commotion there are parallel bands of country where the shocks are less violent. At a still greater distance (as in Northern Italy, for example, extending to the foot of the Alps), there are spaces where the shocks are much rarer and more feeble, yet possibly of sufficient force to cause, by continued repetition, some appreciable alteration in the external form of the earth's crust. Beyond these limits, again, all countries are liable to slight tremors, at distant intervals of time, when some great crisis of subterranean movement agitates an adjoining volcanic region; but these may be considered as mere vibrations, propagated mechanically through the external covering of the globe, as sounds travel almost to indefinite distances through the air. Shocks of this kind have been felt in England, Scotland, Northern France, and Germany—particularly during the Lisbon earthquake. But these countries cannot, on this account, be supposed to constitute parts of the southern volcanic region, any more than the Shetland and Orkney islands can be considered as belonging to the Icelandic circle, because the sands ejected from Hecla have been wafted thither by the winds.

Regarding the volcanic system of Southern Europe, it can be noticed that there is a central area where the strongest earthquakes occur, causing rocks to shatter, mountains to break apart, the ground to rise or fall, and cities to be destroyed. On either side of this line of intense activity, there are parallel regions where the shocks are less severe. Further away (like in Northern Italy, for instance, reaching to the base of the Alps), there are areas where the shocks are much less frequent and weaker, although they might still be strong enough to gradually change the surface of the earth's crust. Beyond these areas, all regions can experience minor tremors at scattered intervals, particularly when some major underground activity stirs up a nearby volcanic zone; however, these should be viewed as mere vibrations that travel through the earth's outer layer, much like sounds can travel long distances through the air. Such shocks have been felt in England, Scotland, Northern France, and Germany—especially during the Lisbon earthquake. But these countries shouldn't be considered part of the southern volcanic region, just as the Shetland and Orkney islands shouldn't be thought of as part of the Icelandic area because sand ejected from Hecla has been blown there by the wind.

359 Besides the continuous spaces of subterranean disturbance, of which we have merely sketched the outline, there are other disconnected volcanic groups, of which several will be mentioned hereafter.

359 In addition to the ongoing areas of underground disruption that we've only briefly outlined, there are other separate volcanic clusters, some of which will be discussed later.

Lines of active and extinct Volcanoes not to be confounded.—We must always be careful to distinguish between lines of extinct and active volcanoes, even where they appear to run in the same direction; for ancient and modern systems may interfere with each other. Already, indeed, we have proof that this is the case; so that it is not by geographical position, but by reference to the species of organic beings alone, whether aquatic or terrestrial, whose remains occur in beds interstratified with lavas, that we can clearly distinguish the relative age of volcanoes of which no eruptions are recorded. Had Southern Italy been known to civilized nations for as short a period as America, we should have had no record of eruptions in Ischia; yet we might have assured ourselves that the lavas of that isle had flowed since the Mediterranean was inhabited by the species of testacea now living in the Neapolitan seas. With this assurance, it would not have been rash to include the numerous vents of that island in the modern volcanic group of Campania.

Lines of active and extinct volcanoes should not be confused.—We always need to be careful to differentiate between lines of extinct and active volcanoes, even when they seem to run in the same direction; ancient and modern systems can overlap. In fact, we already have evidence that this is the case; thus, we can't rely on geographical location alone, but must instead look at the types of living organisms, whether aquatic or terrestrial, whose remains are found in layers mixed with lava to clearly determine the relative age of volcanoes that haven't had recorded eruptions. If Southern Italy had been known to civilized nations for as short a time as America, we wouldn't have any record of eruptions in Ischia; however, we could confidently say that the lavas of that island had flowed since the Mediterranean was populated by the same types of shells that are currently found in the Neapolitan seas. With that certainty, it wouldn’t have been unreasonable to classify the many vents of that island as part of the modern volcanic group of Campania.

On similar grounds we may infer, without much hesitation, that the eruptions of Etna, and the modern earthquakes of Calabria, are a continuation of that action which, at a somewhat earlier period, produced the submarine lavas of the Val di Noto in Sicily. But on the other hand, the lavas of the Euganean hills and the Vicentin, although not wholly beyond the range of earthquakes in Northern Italy, must not be confounded with any existing volcanic system; for when they flowed, the seas were inhabited by animals almost all of them distinct from those now known to live, whether in the Mediterranean or other parts of the globe.

On similar grounds, we can conclude, without much doubt, that the eruptions of Etna and the recent earthquakes in Calabria are a continuation of the activity that earlier created the underwater lavas of the Val di Noto in Sicily. However, the lavas of the Euganean Hills and the Vicentin, although not completely outside the range of earthquakes in Northern Italy, should not be mistaken for any currently active volcanic system; because when they erupted, the seas were home to animals that were almost all different from those known to exist today, whether in the Mediterranean or elsewhere around the world.


CHAPTER XXIII.

VOLCANIC DISTRICT OF NAPLES.

History of the volcanic eruptions in the district round Naples—Early convulsions in the island of Ischia—Numerous cones thrown up there—Lake Avernus—The Solfatara—Renewal of the eruptions of Vesuvius, A.D. 79—Pliny's description of the phenomena—His silence respecting the destruction of Herculaneum and Pompeii—Subsequent history of Vesuvius—Lava discharged in Ischia in 1302—Pause in the eruptions of Vesuvius—Monte Nuovo thrown up—Uniformity of the volcanic operations of Vesuvius and Phlegræan Fields in ancient and modern times.

History of the volcanic eruptions in the area around Naples—Early eruptions on the island of Ischia—Multiple cones formed there—Lake Avernus—The Solfatara—Renewed eruptions of Vesuvius in A.D. 79—Pliny's account of the events—His silence about the destruction of Herculaneum and Pompeii—The later history of Vesuvius—Lava erupted in Ischia in 1302—A break in the eruptions of Vesuvius—Monte Nuovo formed—Consistency of the volcanic activities of Vesuvius and the Phlegræan Fields in both ancient and modern times.

I shall next give a sketch of the history of some of the volcanic vents dispersed throughout the great regions before described, and consider the composition and arrangement of their lavas and ejected matter. The only volcanic region known to the ancients was that of the Mediterranean; and even of this they have transmitted to us very imperfect records relating to the eruptions of the three principal districts, namely, that round Naples, that of Sicily and its isles, and that of the Grecian Archipelago. By far the most connected series of records throughout a long period relates to the first of these provinces; and these cannot be too attentively considered, as much historical information is indispensable in order to enable us to obtain a clear view of the connection and alternate mode of action of the different vents in a single volcanic group.

I will now provide an overview of the history of some volcanic vents scattered across the previously described regions and examine the composition and arrangement of their lavas and ejected materials. The only volcanic area known to ancient civilizations was the Mediterranean, and even regarding this, they passed down very incomplete records about the eruptions in three main areas: around Naples, in Sicily and its islands, and in the Greek Archipelago. The most comprehensive series of records over a long period pertains to the first of these regions, and it is crucial to study these carefully, as much historical information is essential for gaining a clear understanding of how the different vents in a single volcanic group are interconnected and how they alternate in their activity.

Early convulsions in the Island of Ischia.—-The Neapolitan volcanoes extend from Vesuvius, through the Phlegræan Fields, to Procida and Ischia, in a somewhat linear arrangement, ranging from the northeast to the southwest, as will be seen in the annexed map of the volcanic district of Naples (fig. 40). Within the space above limited, the volcanic force is sometimes developed in single eruptions from a considerable number of irregularly scattered points; but a great part of its action has been confined to one principal and habitual vent, Vesuvius or Somma. Before the Christian era, from the remotest periods of which we have any tradition, this principal vent was in a state of inactivity. But terrific convulsions then took place from time to time in Ischia (Pithecusa), and seem to have extended to the neighboring isle of Procida (Prochyta); for Strabo490 mentions a story of Procida having been torn asunder from Ischia; and Pliny491 derives its name from its having been poured forth by an eruption from Ischia.

Early convulsions in the Island of Ischia.—-The Neapolitan volcanoes stretch from Vesuvius, through the Phlegræan Fields, to Procida and Ischia, forming a mostly straight line from the northeast to the southwest, as shown in the attached map of the volcanic area of Naples (fig. 40). Within this specified region, volcanic activity sometimes occurs through single eruptions from a considerable number of irregularly scattered points; however, most of this activity has been concentrated in one main and regular vent, Vesuvius or Somma. Before the Christian era, dating back to the earliest times we have any record of, this main vent was inactive. But there were violent eruptions happening periodically in Ischia (Pithecusa), which appear to have also affected the nearby island of Procida (Prochyta); for Strabo490 tells the story of Procida being separated from Ischia, and Pliny491 explains that its name comes from it being formed by an eruption from Ischia.

The present circumference of Ischia along the water's edge is eighteen miles, its length from west to east about five, and its breadth from north 361 to south three miles. Several Greek colonies which settled there before the Christian era were compelled to abandon it in consequence of the violence of the eruptions. First the Erythræans, and afterwards the Chalcidians, are mentioned as having been driven out by earthquakes and igneous exhalations. A colony was afterwards established by Hiero, king of Syracuse, about 380 years before the Christian era; but when they had built a fortress, they were compelled by an eruption to fly, and never again returned. Strabo tells us that Timæus recorded a tradition, that, a little before his time, Epomeus, the principal mountain in the centre of the island, vomited fire during great earthquakes; that the land between it and the coast had ejected much fiery matter, which flowed into the sea, and that the sea receded for the distance of three stadia, and then returning, overflowed the island. This eruption is supposed by some to have been that which formed the crater of Monte Corvo on one of the higher flanks of Epomeo, above Foria, the lava-current of which may still be traced, by aid of the scoriæ on its surface, from the crater to the sea.

The current perimeter of Ischia along the shoreline is eighteen miles, its length from west to east is about five miles, and its width from north to south is three miles. Several Greek colonies that settled there before the arrival of Christianity were forced to leave due to violent eruptions. First, the Erythræans, and later the Chalcidians, are noted to have been driven out by earthquakes and volcanic activity. A colony was later established by Hiero, king of Syracuse, around 380 years before Christ; however, after they built a fortress, they were forced to escape due to an eruption and never returned. Strabo tells us that Timæus recorded a story that shortly before his time, Epomeus, the main mountain in the center of the island, erupted during significant earthquakes; that the land between it and the coast ejected a lot of molten material, which flowed into the sea, causing the sea to recede for three stadia, and then, returning, flooded the island. Some believe this eruption created the crater of Monte Corvo on one of the higher slopes of Epomeo, above Foria, where the lava flow can still be traced, aided by the scoria on its surface, from the crater to the sea.

Fig. 40.Map of the volcanic district of Naples.

A. Astroni. B. Monte Barbaro.   M. Monte Nuovo.   S. The Solfatara.

A. Astroni. B. Monte Barbaro. M. Monte Nuovo. S. The Solfatara.

To one of the subsequent eruptions in the lower parts of the isle, which caused the expulsion of the first Greek colony, Monte Rotaro has been attributed, and it bears every mark of recent origin. The cone, which I examined in 1828, is remarkably perfect, and has a crater on its summit precisely resembling that of Monte Nuovo near Naples; but the hill is larger, and resembles some of the more considerable cones of single eruption near Clermont in Auvergne, and, like some of them, it has given vent to a lava-stream at its base, instead of its summit. A small ravine swept out by a torrent exposes the structure of 362 the cone, which is composed of innumerable inclined and slightly undulating layers of pumice, scoriæ, white lapilli, and enormous angular blocks of trachyte. These last have evidently been thrown out by violent explosions, like those which in 1822 launched from Vesuvius a mass of augitic lava, of many tons' weight, to the distance of three miles, which fell in the garden of Prince Ottajano. The cone of Rotaro is covered with the arbutus, and other beautiful evergreens. Such is the strength of the virgin soil, that the shrubs have become almost arborescent; and the growth of some of the smaller wild plants has been so vigorous, that botanists have scarcely been able to recognize the species.

To one of the later eruptions in the lower parts of the island, which led to the expulsion of the first Greek colony, Monte Rotaro has been attributed, and it shows clear signs of being a recent formation. The cone, which I looked at in 1828, is strikingly intact and has a crater on its summit that closely resembles that of Monte Nuovo near Naples; however, the hill is larger and resembles some of the more significant cones formed by single eruptions near Clermont in Auvergne. Like some of those, it has released a lava flow from its base instead of its summit. A small ravine carved out by a torrent reveals the structure of 362 the cone, which is made up of countless inclined and slightly wavy layers of pumice, scoria, white lapilli, and huge angular blocks of trachyte. These blocks have clearly been ejected by powerful explosions, similar to those that in 1822 shot a mass of augitic lava weighing several tons over three miles away from Vesuvius, landing in the garden of Prince Ottajano. The cone of Rotaro is adorned with arbutus and other beautiful evergreen plants. The richness of the virgin soil has allowed the shrubs to grow almost tree-like, and some of the smaller wild plants have thrived so much that botanists have had difficulty identifying the species.

The eruption which dislodged the Syracusan colony is supposed to have given rise to that mighty current which forms the promontory of Zaro and Caruso. The surface of these lavas is still very arid and bristling, and is covered with black scoriæ; so that it is not without great labor that human industry has redeemed some small spots, and converted them into vineyards. Upon the produce of these vineyards the population of the island is almost entirely supported. It amounted when I was there, in 1828, to about twenty-five thousand, and was on the increase.

The eruption that displaced the Syracusan colony is believed to have created the powerful current that shapes the promontory of Zaro and Caruso. The surface of these lava flows is still quite dry and jagged, covered with black scoria; thus, it takes significant effort for people to reclaim some small areas and turn them into vineyards. The island's population relies almost entirely on the produce of these vineyards. When I visited in 1828, the population was around twenty-five thousand and was growing.

Fig. 41.Part of Ischia seen from the West.

Part of Ischia seen from the West.

Part of Ischia viewed from the West.

a. Monte Epomeo or San Niccola.
b. Monte Vico.
c. Another of the minor cones with a crater.492

a. Mount Epomeo or San Niccola.
b. Mount Vico.
c. Another one of the smaller cones with a crater.492

From the date of the great eruption last alluded to, down to our own time, Ischia has enjoyed tranquillity, with the exception of one emission of lava hereafter to be described, which, although it occasioned much local damage, does not appear to have devastated the whole country, in the manner of more ancient explosions. There are, upon the whole, on different parts of Epomeo, or scattered through the lower tracts of Ischia, twelve considerable volcanic cones which have been thrown up since the island was raised above the surface of the deep; and many streams of lava may have flowed, like that of "Arso" in 1302, without cones having been produced; so that this island may, for ages before the period of the remotest traditions, have served as a safety-valve to the whole Terra di Lavoro, while the fires of Vesuvius were dormant.

Since the time of the significant eruption mentioned earlier, Ischia has experienced peace, except for one lava flow that will be described later. While this event caused considerable local damage, it didn't destroy the entire region like earlier eruptions did. Overall, there are twelve notable volcanic cones scattered across different areas of Epomeo and the lower regions of Ischia, which have formed since the island emerged from the sea. Many lava flows may have occurred, such as the one from "Arso" in 1302, without producing cones. This means that the island may have acted as a safety valve for the entire Terra di Lavoro for many ages, while the fires of Vesuvius were quiet.

363 Lake Avernus.—It seems also clear that Avernus, a circular lake near Puzzuoli, about half a mile in diameter, which is now a salubrious and cheerful spot, once exhaled mephitic vapors, such as are often emitted by craters after eruptions. There is no reason for discrediting the account of Lucretius, that birds could not fly over it without being stifled, although they may now frequent it uninjured.493 There must have been a time when this crater was in action; and for many centuries afterwards it may have deserved the appellation of "atri jauna Ditis," emitting, perhaps, gases as destructive of animal life as those suffocating vapors given out by Lake Quilotoa, in Quito, in 1797, by which whole herds of cattle on its shores were killed,494 or as those deleterious emanations which annihilated all the cattle in the island of Lancerote, one of the Canaries, in 1730.495 Bory St. Vincent mentions, that in the same isle birds fell lifeless to the ground; and Sir William Hamilton informs us that he picked up dead birds on Vesuvius during an eruption.

363 Lake Avernus.—It also seems clear that Avernus, a round lake near Puzzuoli, which is now a healthy and pleasant place, once released toxic gases, similar to those often emitted by craters after eruptions. There’s no reason to doubt Lucretius's account that birds couldn't fly over it without being suffocated, even though they can now visit it without harm.493 There must have been a time when this crater was active; and for many centuries afterwards, it may have rightly been called "atri jauna Ditis," potentially releasing gases that were as deadly to animals as the suffocating fumes from Lake Quilotoa in Quito in 1797, which killed entire herds of cattle along its shores,494 or like the harmful emissions that wiped out all the cattle on the island of Lanzarote in the Canaries in 1730.495 Bory St. Vincent notes that in the same island, birds fell dead from the sky; and Sir William Hamilton tells us that he found dead birds on Vesuvius during an eruption.

Solfatara.—The Solfatara, near Puzzuoli, which may be considered as a nearly extinguished crater, appears, by the accounts of Strabo and others, to have been before the Christian era in very much the same state as at present, giving vent continually to aqueous vapor, together with sulphureous and muriatic acid gases, like those evolved by Vesuvius.

Solfatara.—The Solfatara, near Puzzuoli, which can be seen as a nearly extinct crater, seems from the reports of Strabo and others to have been in a similar condition before the Christian era as it is today, constantly releasing water vapor along with sulfur and hydrochloric acid gases, similar to those emitted by Vesuvius.

Ancient history of Vesuvius.—Such, then, were the points where the subterranean fires obtained vent, from the earliest period to which tradition reaches back, down to the first century of the Christian era; but we then arrive at a crisis in the volcanic action of this district—one of the most interesting events witnessed by man during the brief period throughout which he has observed the physical changes on the earth's surface. From the first colonization of Southern Italy by the Greeks, Vesuvius afforded no other indications of its volcanic character than such as the naturalist might infer, from the analogy of its structure to other volcanoes. These were recognized by Strabo, but Pliny did not include the mountain in his list of active vents. The ancient cone was of a very regular form, terminating not as at present in two peaks, but with a summit which presented, when seen from a distance, the even outline of an abruptly truncated cone. On the summit, as we learn from Plutarch, there was a crater with steep cliffs, and having its interior overgrown with wild vines, and with a sterile plain at the bottom. On the exterior, the flanks of the mountain were clothed with fertile fields richly cultivated, and at its base were the populous cities of Herculaneum and Pompeii. But the scene of repose was at length doomed to cease, and the volcanic fire was recalled to the main channel, which at some former unknown period had given passage to repeated streams of melted lava, sand, and scoriæ.

Ancient history of Vesuvius.—These were the places where the underground fires released their heat, from the earliest times known to tradition up until the first century of the Christian era; however, we then reach a turning point in the volcanic activity of this area—one of the most fascinating events recorded by humanity during the short span in which we have observed the earth's physical changes. From the time the Greeks first colonized Southern Italy, Vesuvius gave no other signs of its volcanic nature beyond what a naturalist might deduce from its resemblance to other volcanoes. Strabo recognized these similarities, but Pliny did not list the mountain among his active vents. The ancient cone had a very regular shape, ending not as it does now in two peaks, but with a summit that, when viewed from afar, had the smooth outline of a sharply truncated cone. At the top, as noted by Plutarch, there was a crater with steep cliffs, its interior covered in wild vines, and a barren plain at the bottom. On the outside, the slopes of the mountain were adorned with fertile fields that were richly cultivated, and at its foot were the bustling cities of Herculaneum and Pompeii. But this peaceful scene was ultimately destined to end, as volcanic fire returned to the main channel, which had once, at an unknown time, allowed the flow of repeated streams of molten lava, sand, and scoria.

364 Renewal of its eruptions.—The first symptom of the revival of the energies of this volcano was the occurrence of an earthquake in the year 63 after Christ, which did considerable injury to the cities in its vicinity. From that time to the year 79 slight shocks were frequent; and in the month of August of that year they became more numerous and violent, till they ended at length in an eruption. The elder Pliny, who commanded the Roman fleet, was then stationed at Misenum; and in his anxiety to obtain a near view of the phenomena, he lost his life, being suffocated by sulphureous vapors. His nephew, the younger Pliny, remained at Misenum, and has given us, in his Letters, a lively description of the awful scene. A dense column of vapor was first seen rising vertically from Vesuvius, and then spreading itself out laterally, so that its upper portion resembled the head, and its lower the trunk of the pine, which characterizes the Italian landscape. This black cloud was pierced occasionally by flashes of fire, as vivid as lightning, succeeded by darkness more profound than night. Ashes fell even upon the ships at Misenum, and caused a shoal in one part of the sea—the ground rocked, and the sea receded from the shores, so that many marine animals were seen on the dry sand. The appearances above described agree perfectly with those witnessed in more recent eruptions, especially those of Monte Nuovo, in 1538, and of Vesuvius in 1822.

364 Renewal of its eruptions.—The first sign of this volcano's renewed activity was an earthquake in 63 AD, which caused significant damage to nearby cities. From that point until 79 AD, minor tremors occurred frequently; however, in August of that year, these tremors became more common and intense, ultimately leading to an eruption. The elder Pliny, who was in command of the Roman fleet, was stationed at Misenum. Eager to see the event up close, he tragically lost his life, suffocated by sulfurous fumes. His nephew, the younger Pliny, stayed at Misenum and provided us with a vivid account of the terrifying scene in his Letters. A thick column of vapor was seen shooting straight up from Vesuvius, then spreading out sideways, resembling the shape of a pine tree, with its top as the head and its bottom as the trunk—a feature typical of the Italian landscape. This dark cloud was intermittently illuminated by fiery flashes as bright as lightning, followed by darkness deeper than night. Ashes even fell on the ships at Misenum, creating a shallow area in the sea—the ground shook, and the sea pulled back from the shore, exposing many marine creatures on the dry sand. The described phenomena align perfectly with those observed in more recent eruptions, particularly those of Monte Nuovo in 1538 and Vesuvius in 1822.

The younger Pliny, although giving a circumstantial detail of so many physical facts, and describing the eruption and earthquake, and the shower of ashes which fell at Stabiæ, makes no allusion to the sudden overwhelming of two large and populous cities, Herculaneum and Pompeii. In explanation of this omission, it has been suggested that his chief object was simply to give Tacitus a full account of the particulars of his uncle's death. It is worthy, however, of remark, that had the buried cities never been discovered, the accounts transmitted to us of their tragical end might well have been discredited by the majority, so vague and general are the narratives, or so long subsequent to the event. Tacitus, the friend and contemporary of Pliny, when adverting in general terms to the convulsions, says merely that "cities were consumed or buried."496

The younger Pliny, while providing detailed accounts of many physical phenomena, and describing the eruption and earthquake, along with the rain of ashes that fell on Stabiæ, doesn't mention the sudden destruction of the two large and populated cities, Herculaneum and Pompeii. It has been suggested that his main goal was simply to give Tacitus a complete report of his uncle's death. However, it's worth noting that if the buried cities had never been found, the accounts we have of their tragic end might have been dismissed by most people, because the narratives are so vague and general, or they come so long after the events. Tacitus, who was a friend and contemporary of Pliny, when briefly mentioning the disruptions, states only that "cities were destroyed or buried."496

Suetonius, although he alludes to the eruption incidentally, is silent as to the cities. They are mentioned by Martial, in an epigram, as immersed in cinders; but the first historian who alludes to them by name is Dion Cassius,497 who flourished about a century and a half after Pliny. He appears to have derived his information from the traditions of the inhabitants, and to have recorded, without discrimination, all the facts and fables which he could collect. He tells us, "that during the eruption a multitude of men of superhuman stature, resembling giants, appeared, sometimes on the mountain, and sometimes in the environs—that stones and smoke were thrown out, the sun was hidden, and then the giants seemed to rise again, while the sounds of trumpets were heard, &c., &c.; and finally," he relates, "two entire cities, Herculaneum 365 and Pompeii, were buried under showers of ashes, while all the people were sitting in the theatre." That many of these circumstances were invented, would have been obvious, even without the aid of Pliny's letters; and the examination of Herculaneum and Pompeii enables us to prove, that none of the people were destroyed in the theatres, and indeed that there were very few of the inhabitants who did not escape from both cities. Yet some lives were lost, and there was ample foundation for the tale in its most essential particulars.

Suetonius briefly mentions the eruption but doesn't talk about the cities. Martial refers to them in a poem, describing them as covered in ash; however, the first historian to name them is Dio Cassius,497 who lived about a century and a half after Pliny. He seems to have gotten his info from local legends and noted everything he could find, mixing facts and myths. He mentions that during the eruption, many people of enormous size, like giants, appeared at times on the mountain and in the surrounding areas. He describes how stones and smoke erupted, the sun disappeared, and then the giants seemed to rise again while sounds of trumpets were heard, etc., etc. Ultimately, he recounts that two whole cities, Herculaneum 365 and Pompeii, were buried under showers of ash while everyone was sitting in the theater. It would have been clear that many of these details were fabricated, even without Pliny's letters; and investigating Herculaneum and Pompeii shows that none of the people were killed in the theaters, and in fact, very few residents from both cities did not manage to escape. Still, some lives were lost, and the core of the story has a solid basis.

It does not appear that in the year 79 any lava flowed from Vesuvius; the ejected substances, perhaps, consisted entirely of lapilli, sand, and fragments of older lava, as when Monte Nuovo was thrown up in 1538. The first era at which we have authentic accounts of the flowing of a stream of lava, is the year 1036, which is the seventh eruption from the revival of the fires of the volcano. A few years afterwards, in 1049, another eruption is mentioned, and another in 1138 (or 1139), after which a great pause ensued of 168 years. During this long interval of repose, two minor vents opened at distant points. First, it is on tradition that an eruption took place from the Solfatara, in the year 1198, during the reign of Frederick II., Emperor of Germany; and although no circumstantial detail of the event has reached us from those dark ages, we may receive the fact without hesitation.498 Nothing more, however, can be attributed to this eruption, as Mr. Scrope observes, than the discharge of a light and scoriform trachytic lava, of recent aspect, resting upon the strata of loose tuff which covers the principal mass of trachyte.499

It seems that in the year 79, no lava flowed from Vesuvius; the materials that were ejected likely consisted entirely of lapilli, sand, and pieces of older lava, similar to when Monte Nuovo erupted in 1538. The first documented instance of a lava flow occurred in 1036, marking the seventh eruption since the volcano's fires reignited. A few years later, another eruption was recorded in 1049, followed by another in 1138 (or 1139), after which there was a significant pause of 168 years. During this long period of inactivity, two minor vents opened at different locations. First, tradition holds that an eruption happened at the Solfatara in 1198, during the reign of Frederick II, Emperor of Germany; although no detailed accounts of the event have survived from those dark times, we can accept the fact without doubt.498 However, as Mr. Scrope notes, nothing more can be attributed to this eruption than the release of a light and pumice-like trachytic lava, which looks relatively new, layering on top of the loose tuff that covers the main mass of trachyte.499

Volcanic eruption in Ischia, 1302.—The other occurrence is well authenticated—the eruption, in the year 1302, of a lava-stream from a new vent on the southeast end of the Island of Ischia. During part of 1301, earthquakes had succeeded one another with fearful rapidity; and they terminated at last with the discharge of a lava-stream from a point named the Campo del Arso, not far from the town of Ischia. This lava ran quite down to the sea—a distance of about two miles; in color it varies from iron-gray to reddish black, and is remarkable for the glassy felspar which it contains. Its surface is almost as sterile, after a period of five centuries, as if it had cooled down yesterday. A few scantlings of wild thyme, and two or three other dwarfish plants, alone appear in the interstices of the scoriæ, while the Vesuvian lava of 1767 is already covered with a luxuriant vegetation. Pontanus, whose country-house was burnt and overwhelmed, describes the dreadful scene as having lasted two months.500 Many houses were swallowed up, and a partial emigration of the inhabitants followed. This eruption produced no cone, but only a slight depression, hardly deserving the name of a crater, 366 where heaps of black and red scoriæ lie scattered around. Until this eruption, Ischia is generally believed to have enjoyed an interval of rest for about seventeen centuries; but Julius Obsequens,501 who flourished A. D. 214, refers to some volcanic convulsions in the year 662 after the building of Rome (91 B. C.) As Pliny, who lived a century before Obsequens, does not enumerate this among other volcanic eruptions, the statement of the latter author is supposed to have been erroneous; but it would be more consistent, for reasons before stated, to disregard the silence of Pliny, and to conclude, that some kind of subterranean commotion, probably of no great violence, happened at the period alluded to.

Volcanic eruption in Ischia, 1302.—The other event is well documented—the eruption in 1302 of a lava flow from a new vent at the southeast end of Ischia Island. Throughout much of 1301, earthquakes occurred in rapid succession, ultimately leading to the eruption of lava from a location called the Campo del Arso, near the town of Ischia. This lava flowed all the way to the sea, about two miles away; its color ranges from iron-gray to reddish black, and it is notable for containing glassy feldspar. Even after five centuries, its surface appears almost as barren as if it had just cooled. Only a few sparse wild thyme plants and a couple of other small plants can be found in the cracks of the scoria, while the Vesuvian lava from 1767 is already covered in rich vegetation. Pontanus, whose villa was destroyed and buried, describes the terrifying events as lasting two months.500 Many homes were engulfed, leading to some of the residents relocating. This eruption did not create a cone, just a slight depression that hardly qualifies as a crater, 366 where piles of black and red scoria are scattered around. Until this eruption, Ischia was thought to have enjoyed a period of calm for about seventeen centuries; however, Julius Obsequens,501 who lived around A. D. 214, mentions some volcanic activity in the year 662 after the founding of Rome (91 B. C.). Since Pliny, who lived a century before Obsequens, does not include this in his list of volcanic eruptions, it is believed that Obsequens might have been mistaken; however, it may be more logical, for the reasons previously stated, to ignore Pliny's silence and assume that some sort of subterranean disturbance, likely not very severe, occurred during the time in question.

History of Vesuvius after 1138.—To return to Vesuvius:—the next eruption occurred in 1306; between which era and 1631 there was only one other (in 1500), and that a slight one. It has been remarked, that throughout this period Etna was in a state of such unusual activity, as to lend countenance to the idea that the great Sicilian volcano may sometimes serve as a channel of discharge to elastic fluids and lava that would otherwise rise to the vents in Campania.

History of Vesuvius after 1138.—Back to Vesuvius: the next eruption happened in 1306; between that time and 1631, there was only one other eruption (in 1500), and it was minor. It has been noted that during this period, Etna was unusually active, suggesting that the great Sicilian volcano might sometimes act as a release point for gases and lava that would otherwise reach the vents in Campania.

Formation of Monte Nuovo, 1538.—The great pause was also marked by a memorable event in the Phlegræan Fields—the sudden formation of a new mountain in 1538, of which we have received authentic accounts from contemporary writers.

Formation of Monte Nuovo, 1538.—The great pause was also marked by a significant event in the Phlegræan Fields—the sudden formation of a new mountain in 1538, which we have reliable accounts of from contemporary writers.

Fig. 42.Monte Nuovo.

Monte Nuovo, formed in the Bay of Baiæ, Sept. 29th, 1538.

Monte Nuovo, created in the Bay of Baiae, Sept. 29, 1538.

1. Cone of Monte Nuovo.
2. Brim of crater of ditto.
3. Thermal spring, called Baths of Nero, or Stufe di Tritoli.

1. Cone of Monte Nuovo.
2. Edge of the crater of the same.
3. Hot spring, known as the Baths of Nero, or Stufe di Tritoli.

The height of this mountain, called ever since Monte Nuovo, has been determined by the Italian mineralogist Pini, to be 440 English feet above the level of the bay; its base is about eight thousand feet, or more than a mile and a half in circumference. According to Pini, the 367 depth of the crater is 421 English feet from the summit of the hill, so that its bottom is only nineteen feet above the level of the sea. The cone is declared, by the best authorities, to stand partly on the site of the Lucrine Lake (4, fig. 43),502 which was nothing more than the crater of a pre-existent volcano, and was almost entirely filled during the explosion of 1538. Nothing now remains but a shallow pool, separated from the sea by an elevated beach, raised artificially.

The height of this mountain, known since as Monte Nuovo, has been measured by the Italian mineralogist Pini to be 440 feet above the bay's level; its base is about eight thousand feet around, or more than a mile and a half in circumference. According to Pini, the crater's depth is 421 feet from the hill's summit, making its bottom only nineteen feet above sea level. Experts say the cone is partly located on the site of Lucrine Lake (4, fig. 43),502 which was essentially the crater of an earlier volcano, mostly filled during the explosion of 1538. Now, all that’s left is a shallow pool, separated from the sea by an artificially raised beach.

Fig. 43.The Phlegraean Fields.

The Phlegræan Fields.

The Phlegraean Fields.

1. Monte Nuovo. 4. Lucrine Lake.
2. Monte Barbaro. 5. The Solfatara.
3. Lake Avernus. 6. Puzzuoli.

7. Bay of Baiæ.

7. Bay of Baiae.

Sir William Hamilton has given us two original letters describing this eruption. The first, by Falconi, dated 1538, contains the following passages.503 "It is now two years since there have been frequent earthquakes at Puzzuoli, Naples, and the neighboring parts. On the day and in the night before the eruption (of Monte Nuovo), above twenty shocks, great and small, were felt. The eruption began on the 29th of September, 1538. It was on a Sunday, about one o'clock in the night, when flames of fire were seen between the hot baths and Tripergola. In a short time the fire increased to such a degree, that it burst open the earth in this place, and threw up so great a quantity of ashes and pumice-stones, mixed with water, as covered the whole country. The next morning (after the formation of Monte Nuovo) the poor inhabitants of Puzzuoli quitted their habitations in terror, covered with the muddy and black shower which continued the whole day in that country—flying from death, but with death painted in their countenances. Some with their children in their arms, some with sacks full of their goods; others leading an ass, loaded with their frightened family, towards Naples; 368 others carrying quantities of birds, of various sorts, that had fallen dead at the beginning of the eruption; others, again, with fish which they had found, and which were to be met with in plenty on the shore, the sea having left them dry for a considerable time. I accompanied Signor Moramaldo to behold the wonderful effects of the eruption. The sea had retired on the side of Baiæ, abandoning a considerable tract, and the shore appeared almost entirely dry, from the quantity of ashes and broken pumice-stones thrown up by the eruption. I saw two springs in the newly discovered ruins; one before the house that was the queen's, of hot and salt water," &c.

Sir William Hamilton has provided us with two original letters detailing this eruption. The first, from Falconi and dated 1538, includes the following excerpts.503 "It has now been two years since numerous earthquakes have occurred in Puzzuoli, Naples, and surrounding areas. On the day and the night before the eruption (of Monte Nuovo), over twenty tremors, both large and small, were felt. The eruption started on September 29, 1538. It was a Sunday, around one o'clock in the morning, when flames were spotted between the hot baths and Tripergola. Soon, the fire grew so intense that it broke open the earth in that area, projecting a massive amount of ashes and pumice stones, mixed with water, that covered the entire region. The following morning (after the formation of Monte Nuovo), the frightened residents of Puzzuoli fled their homes in terror, covered in the muddy and black downpour that lasted all day—running from death, yet visibly marked by it. Some carried their children, others had sacks filled with their belongings; some led a donkey loaded with their scared family toward Naples; 368 others were carrying various dead birds that had fallen at the onset of the eruption; and others again had fish they found scattered on the shore, left stranded by the sea for quite some time. I joined Signor Moramaldo to witness the astonishing impacts of the eruption. The sea had receded along the Baiæ side, leaving a significant area exposed, and the shore appeared almost completely dry due to the ashes and broken pumice stones ejected by the eruption. I observed two springs in the newly uncovered ruins; one in front of what used to be the queen's house, consisting of hot and salty water," &c.

So far Falconi: the other account is by Pietro Giacomo di Toledo, which begins thus:—"It is now two years since this province of Campagna has been afflicted with earthquakes, the country about Puzzuoli much more so than any other parts; but the 27th and the 28th of the month of September last, the earthquakes did not cease day or night in the town of Puzzuoli: that plain which lies between Lake Avernus, the Monte Barbaro, and the sea, was raised a little, and many cracks were made in it, from some of which issued water; at the same time the sea, immediately joining the plain, dried up about two hundred paces, so that the fish were left on the sand a prey to the inhabitants of Puzzuoli. At last, on the 29th of the same month, about two o'clock in the night, the earth opened near the lake, and discovered a horrid mouth, from which were vomited furiously smoke, fire, stones, and mud, composed of ashes, making at the time of its opening a noise like the loudest thunder. The stones which followed were by the flames converted to pumice, and some of these were larger than an ox. The stones went about as high as a cross-bow can carry, and then fell down, sometimes on the edge, and sometimes into the mouth itself. The mud was of the color of ashes, and at first very liquid, then by degrees less so, and in such quantities, that in less than twelve hours, with the help of the above-mentioned stones, a mountain was raised of 1000 paces in height. Not only Puzzuoli and the neighboring country was full of this mud, but the city of Naples also; so that many of its palaces were defaced by it. Now this eruption lasted two nights and two days without intermission, though, it is true, not always with the same force; the third day the eruption ceased, and I went up with many people to the top of the new hill, and saw down into its mouth, which was a round cavity about a quarter of a mile in circumference, in the middle of which, the stones which had fallen were boiling up, just as a caldron of water boils on the fire. The fourth day it began to throw up again, and the seventh much more, but still with less violence than the first night. At this time many persons who were on the hill were knocked down by the stones and killed, or smothered with the smoke. In the day the smoke still continues, and you often see fire in the midst of it in the nighttime."504

So far, Falconi: the other account is by Pietro Giacomo di Toledo, which starts like this:—"It's been two years since this region of Campagna has been hit by earthquakes, with the area around Puzzuoli being affected more than anywhere else. But on the 27th and 28th of September last year, the earthquakes didn’t stop day or night in Puzzuoli. The plain between Lake Avernus, Monte Barbaro, and the sea was raised a bit, and many cracks formed in it, some of which released water. At the same time, the sea right next to the plain dried up by about two hundred paces, leaving fish stranded on the sand for the people of Puzzuoli to catch. Finally, on the 29th of that month, around two o'clock in the morning, the ground opened near the lake, revealing a terrifying opening that unleashed smoke, fire, stones, and mud made of ashes with a roar that sounded like thunder. The stones that followed were turned into pumice by the flames, and some were larger than an ox. They shot up as high as a crossbow can launch and then fell either to the sides or right back into the opening itself. The mud was ash-colored, initially very fluid but gradually thickening, and in such great amounts that in less than twelve hours, alongside the previously mentioned stones, a mountain was formed that was 1000 paces high. Not only was Puzzuoli and its surrounding area covered in this mud, but the city of Naples was too, damaging many of its palaces. This eruption lasted for two nights and two days without stopping, although it wasn't always as forceful. On the third day, the eruption stopped, and I went up with many others to the top of the new hill and looked into its mouth, which was a round cavity about a quarter of a mile in circumference, where the fallen stones were bubbling like water in a boiling pot. On the fourth day, it started to erupt again, and on the seventh day even more, but still less violently than the first night. During this time, many people on the hill were hit by the stones and killed or suffocated by the smoke. During the day, the smoke persisted, and at night you often see fire glowing in the middle of it." 504

It will be seen that both these accounts, written immediately after the 369 birth of Monte Nuovo, agree in stating that the sea retired; and one mentions that its bottom was upraised; but they attribute the origin of the new hill exclusively to the jets of mud, showers of scoriæ, and large fragments of rock, cast out from a central orifice, for several days and nights. Baron Von Buch, however, in his excellent work on the Canary Islands, and volcanic phenomena in general, has declared his opinion that the cone and crater of Monte Nuovo were formed, not in the manner above described, but by the upheaval of solid beds of white tuff, which were previously horizontal, but which were pushed up in 1538, so as to dip away in all directions from the centre, with the same inclination as the sloping surface of the cone itself. "It is an error," he says, "to imagine that this hill was formed by eruption, or by the ejection of pumice, scoriæ, and other incoherent matter; for the solid beds of upraised tuff are visible all round the crater, and it is merely the superficial covering of the cone which is made up of ejected scoriæ."505

Both accounts, written right after the birth of Monte Nuovo, state that the sea receded; one even mentions that the seabed was raised. However, they mainly attribute the creation of the new hill to jets of mud, showers of scoria, and large rock fragments ejected from a central opening over several days and nights. Baron Von Buch, in his outstanding work on the Canary Islands and volcanic phenomena in general, argues that the cone and crater of Monte Nuovo were formed differently. He suggests they resulted from the uplift of solid beds of white tuff that were originally horizontal but were pushed up in 1538, causing them to slope away from the center, mirroring the angle of the cone's surface. "It is a mistake," he states, "to think this hill was created by an eruption or by ejecting pumice, scoria, and other loose materials; the solid layers of raised tuff can be seen all around the crater, and only the outer layer of the cone is made up of ejected scoria."

In confirmation of this view, M. Dufrénoy has cited a passage from the works of Porzio, a celebrated physician of that period, to prove that in 1538 the ground where Monte Nuovo stands was pushed up in the form of a great bubble or blister, which on bursting, gave origin to the present deep crater. Porzio, says, "that after two days and nights of violent earthquakes, the sea retired for nearly 200 yards; so that the inhabitants could collect great numbers of fish on this part of the shore, and see some springs of fresh water which rose up there. At length, on the third day of the calends of October (September 29), they saw a large tract of ground intervening between the foot of Monte Barbaro, and part of the sea, near the Lake Avernus, rise, and suddenly assume the form of an incipient hill; and at two o'clock at night, this heap of earth, opening as it were its mouth, vomited, with a loud noise, flames, pumice-stones, and ashes."506

To support this view, M. Dufrénoy cited a passage from the works of Porzio, a renowned physician of that time, to show that in 1538, the ground where Monte Nuovo is located was pushed up like a huge bubble or blister, which, when it burst, created the current deep crater. Porzio states, "after two days and nights of intense earthquakes, the sea receded nearly 200 yards; so that the inhabitants were able to gather a large number of fish from this area of the shore and observe fresh water springs that appeared there. Finally, on the third day of the calends of October (September 29), they saw a large area of land between the foot of Monte Barbaro and part of the sea near Lake Avernus rise and quickly take the shape of a budding hill; and at two o'clock in the morning, this mound of earth, as if opening its mouth, erupted with a loud noise, spewing flames, pumice stones, and ashes."506

So late as the year 1846 a fourth manuscript (written immediately after the eruption) was discovered and published in Germany. It was written in 1538 by Francesco del Nero,507 who mentions the drying up of the bed of the sea near Puzzuoli, which enabled the inhabitants of the town to carry off loads of fish. About eight o'clock in the morning of the 29th September, the earth sunk down about 14 feet in that place where the volcanic orifice now appears, and there issued forth a small stream of water, at first cold, and afterwards tepid. At noon, on the same day, the earth began to swell up in the same spot where it had sunk down 14 feet, so as to form a hill. About this time fire 370 issued forth, and gave rise to the great gulf, "with such a force, noise, and shining light, that I, who was standing in my garden, was seized with terror. Forty minutes afterwards, although unwell, I got upon a neighboring height, from which I saw all that took place, and by my troth it was a splendid fire, that threw up for a long time much earth and many stones, which fell back again all round the gulf, in a semicircle of from one to three bow-shots in diameter, and, filling up part of the sea, formed a hill nearly of the height of Monte Morello. Masses of earth and stones, as large as an ox, were shot up from the fiery gulf into the air, to a height which I estimate at a mile and a half. When they descended, some were dry, others in a soft muddy state." He concludes by alluding again to the sinking of the ground, and the elevation of it which followed, and says that to him it was inconceivable how such a mass of stones and ashes could have been poured forth from the gulf. He also refers to the account which Porzio was to draw up for the Viceroy.

So late as the year 1846, a fourth manuscript (written right after the eruption) was discovered and published in Germany. It was written in 1538 by Francesco del Nero,507 who mentions that the sea bed near Puzzuoli had dried up, allowing the townspeople to carry off loads of fish. Around eight o'clock in the morning on September 29th, the ground sank about 14 feet in the spot where the volcanic opening now exists. A small stream of water started to flow, initially cold and later warm. By noon that same day, the earth began to swell up in the same place it had sunk, forming a hill. At this time, fire erupted, creating the great gulf, "with such force, noise, and brilliant light that I, standing in my garden, was struck with fear. Forty minutes later, though feeling unwell, I climbed up a nearby hill from which I could see everything happening, and honestly, it was an amazing fire that launched a lot of earth and stones into the air, which fell back all around the gulf in a semicircle measuring from one to three bowshots in diameter, and, filling part of the sea, created a hill nearly as tall as Monte Morello. Large masses of earth and stones, as big as an ox, were shot up from the fiery gulf into the air, reaching an estimated height of a mile and a half. When they fell, some were dry, while others were soft and muddy." He concludes by mentioning the sinking and subsequent rising of the ground and expresses that it was unimaginable to him how such a mass of stones and ashes could have been released from the gulf. He also references the account that Porzio was going to prepare for the Viceroy.

On comparing these four accounts, recorded by eye-witnesses, there appears to be no real discrepancy between them. It seems clear that the ground first sunk down 14 feet on the site of the future volcano, and after having subsided it was again propelled upwards by the lava mingled with steam and gases, which were about to burst forth. Jets of red-hot lava, fragments of fractured rock, and occasionally mud composed of a mixture of pumice, tuff, and sea-water, were hurled into the air. Some of the blocks of stone were very large, leading us to infer that the ground which sank and rose again was much shattered and torn to pieces by the elastic vapors. The whole hill was not formed at once, but by an intermittent action extending over a week or more. It seems that the chasm opened between Tripergola and the baths in its suburbs, and that the ejected materials fell and buried that small town. A considerable part, however, of the hill was formed in less than twenty-four hours, and in the same manner as on a smaller scale the mud cones of the air volcanoes are produced, with a cavity in the middle. There is no difficulty in conceiving that the pumiceous mud, if so thrown out, may have set into a kind of stone on drying, just as some cements, composed of volcanic ashes, are known to consolidate with facility.

When we compare these four accounts from witnesses, there doesn’t seem to be any significant differences among them. It’s clear that the ground initially sunk 14 feet where the future volcano would be. After it subsided, it was pushed back up by lava mixed with steam and gases that were about to erupt. Jets of molten lava, pieces of broken rock, and occasionally mud made up of pumice, tuff, and seawater were shot into the air. Some of the stone blocks were very large, suggesting that the ground that sank and rose again was heavily damaged and torn apart by the pressurized vapors. The entire hill didn’t form all at once, but rather through intermittent activity over a week or more. It seems that a chasm opened up between Tripergola and the nearby baths, and the materials that were ejected fell and buried that small town. However, a significant portion of the hill was built up in less than twenty-four hours, in a manner similar to how the mud cones of air volcanoes are formed, with a hollow center. It's easy to think that the pumice mud, if ejected, might harden into a type of stone when it dried, just like some cements made from volcanic ash are known to easily solidify.

I am informed that Baron Von Buch discovered some marine shells of existing species, such as occur fossil in the tuff of the neighborhood, in beds exposed low down in the walls of the crater of Monte Nuovo. These may have been ejected in the mud mixed with sea-water which was cast out of the boiling gulf; or, as Signor Arcangelo Scacchi has suggested,508 they may have been derived from the older tuff, which contains marine shells of recent species. The same observer remarks that Porzio's account upon the whole corroborates the doctrine of the cone having been formed by eruption, in proof of which he cites the 371 following passage:—"But what was truly astonishing, a hill of pumice-stones and ashes was heaped up round the gulf to the height of a mile in a single night."509 Signor Scacchi also adds that the ancient temple of Apollo, now at the foot of Monte Nuovo, and the walls of which still retain their perfect perpendicularity, could not possibly have maintained that position had the cone of Monte Nuovo really been the result of upheaval.

I’ve heard that Baron Von Buch found some marine shells from species that still exist today, which are also found as fossils in the local tuff, in layers exposed low in the walls of the Monte Nuovo crater. These could have been thrown out with the mud mixed with seawater that was expelled from the boiling gulf; or, as Signor Arcangelo Scacchi has suggested,508 they might have come from the older tuff, which contains marine shells of recent species. The same observer notes that Porzio’s account generally supports the idea that the cone was formed by an eruption, providing evidence with the following statement:—"But what was truly astonishing, a hill of pumice-stones and ashes was heaped up round the gulf to the height of a mile in a single night."509 Signor Scacchi also points out that the ancient temple of Apollo, now located at the foot of Monte Nuovo, which still has perfectly upright walls, wouldn’t have been able to maintain that position if the Monte Nuovo cone had really formed from upheaval.

Tripergola was much frequented as a watering-place, and contained a hospital for those who resorted there for the benefit of the thermal springs; and it appears that there were no fewer than three inns in the principal street. Had Porzio stated that any of these buildings, or the ruins of them, were seen by himself or others raised up above the plain, a short time before the first eruption, so as to stand on the summit or slope of a newly-raised hillock, we might have been compelled, by so circumstantial a narrative, to adopt M. Dufrénoy's interpretation.

Tripergola was a popular spot for relaxation and had a hospital for visitors looking to benefit from the thermal springs. There seemed to be at least three inns along the main street. If Porzio had mentioned that he or others saw any of these buildings, or their ruins, elevated above the plain shortly before the first eruption—situated on the top or slope of a newly formed hillock—we might have been forced, based on such detailed information, to accept M. Dufrénoy's explanation.

But in the absence of such evidence, we must appeal to the crater itself, where we behold a section of the whole mountain, without being able to detect any original nucleus of upheaved rock distinct from the rest; on the contrary, the whole mass is similar throughout in composition, and the cone very symmetrical in form; nor are there any clefts, such as might be looked for, as the effect of the sudden upthrow of stony masses. M. C. Prevost has well remarked, that if beds of solid and non-elastic materials had yielded to a violent pressure directed from below upward, we should find not simply a deep empty cavity, but an Fig. 44.Walls of the craters. irregular opening, where many rents converged; and these rents would be now seen breaking through the walls of the crater, widening as they approach the centre. (See Fig. 44, a, b.)510 Not a single fissure of this kind is observable in the interior of Monte Nuovo, where the walls of the crater are continuous and entire; nor are there any dikes implying that rents had existed, which were afterwards filled with lava or other matter.

But in the absence of such evidence, we have to look at the crater itself, where we see a section of the entire mountain, without being able to identify any original core of uplifted rock distinct from the rest; on the contrary, the entire mass is uniformly composed, and the cone is very symmetrical in shape; nor are there any cracks, which one might expect as a result of the sudden upward force on rocky masses. M. C. Prevost has aptly noted that if layers of solid and non-elastic materials had responded to a violent pressure from below, we wouldn’t just find a deep empty space, but an Fig. 44.Walls of the craters. irregular opening, where many cracks would converge; and these cracks would now be visible breaking through the walls of the crater, widening as they approach the center. (See Fig. 44, a, b.)510 Not a single crack of this sort is visible in the interior of Monte Nuovo, where the walls of the crater are continuous and intact; nor are there any dikes suggesting that cracks existed, which were later filled with lava or other material.

It has moreover been often urged by Von Buch, De Beaumont, and others, who ascribe the conical form of volcanoes chiefly to upheaval from below, that in such mountains there are a great number of deep rents and ravines, which diverge on all sides like the spokes of a wheel, from near the central axis to the circumference or base of the cone, as in the case of Palma, Cantal, and Teneriffe. Yet the entire absence of such divergent fissures or ravines, in such cases as Monte Nuovo, Somma, or Etna, is passed by unnoticed, and appears to have raised in their minds no objection to their favorite theory.

It has frequently been pointed out by Von Buch, De Beaumont, and others, who believe that the cone shape of volcanoes mainly comes from forces pushing up from below, that these mountains have many deep cracks and valleys that spread out like the spokes of a wheel, from near the center to the edge or base of the cone, as seen in Palma, Cantal, and Teneriffe. However, the complete lack of such divergent cracks or valleys in cases like Monte Nuovo, Somma, or Etna seems to go unnoticed and does not appear to pose any challenges to their preferred theory.

It is, indeed, admitted by M. Dufrénoy that there are some facts 372 which it is very difficult to reconcile with his own view of Porzio's record. Thus, for example, there are certain Roman monuments at the base of Monte Nuovo, and on the borders of Lake Avernus, such as the temples of Apollo (before mentioned) and Pluto, which do not seem to have suffered in the least degree by the supposed upheaval. "The walls which still exist have preserved their vertical position, and the vaults are in the same state as other monuments on the shores of the Bay of Baiæ. The long gallery which led to the Sibyl's Cave, on the other side of Lake Avernus, has in like manner escaped injury, the roof of the gallery remaining perfectly horizontal, the only change being that the soil of the chamber in which the Sibyl gave out her oracles is now covered by a few inches of water, which merely indicates a slight alteration in the level of Lake Avernus."511 On the supposition, then, that pre-existing beds of pumiceous tuff were upraised in 1538, so as to form Monte Nuovo, it is acknowledged that the perfectly undisturbed state of the contiguous soil on which these ancient monuments stand, is very different from what might have been expected.

It is, indeed, acknowledged by M. Dufrénoy that there are some facts 372 that are really hard to reconcile with his own interpretation of Porzio's record. For instance, there are several Roman monuments at the base of Monte Nuovo and along the shores of Lake Avernus, like the temples of Apollo (mentioned earlier) and Pluto, which don’t seem to have been affected at all by the supposed upheaval. "The walls that still stand have maintained their vertical position, and the vaults are in the same condition as other monuments along the shores of the Bay of Baiæ. The long gallery leading to the Sibyl's Cave, on the other side of Lake Avernus, has also remained unharmed, with the roof of the gallery staying perfectly horizontal. The only change is that the floor of the chamber where the Sibyl offered her oracles is now filled with a few inches of water, which merely suggests a slight change in the level of Lake Avernus." 511 So, if we assume that existing layers of pumiceous tuff were raised in 1538 to form Monte Nuovo, it's recognized that the completely undisturbed condition of the surrounding soil where these ancient monuments are located is quite different from what might have been expected.

Mr. Darwin, in his "Volcanic Islands," has described several crateriform hills in the Galapagos Archipelago as composed of tuff which has evidently flowed like mud, and yet on consolidating has preserved an inclination of twenty and even thirty degrees. The tuff does not fold in continuous sheets round the hills as would have happened if they had been formed by the upheaval of horizontal layers. The author describes the composition of the tuff as very similar to that of Monte Nuovo, and the high angles at which the beds slope, both those which have flowed and those which have fallen in the form of ashes, entirely removes the difficulty supposed by M. Dufrénoy to exist in regard to the slope of Monte Nuovo, where it exceeds an angle of 18° to 20°.512 Mr. Dana, also, in his account of the Sandwich Islands,513 shows that in the "cinder cones" of that region, the strata have an original inclination of between 35° and 40°, while in the "tufa cones" formed near the sea, the beds slope at about an angle of 30°. The same naturalist also observed in the Samoan or Navigator Islands in Polynesia, that fragments of fresh coral had been thrown up together with volcanic matter to the height of 200 feet above the level of the sea in cones of tufa.514

Mr. Darwin, in his "Volcanic Islands," describes several crater-like hills in the Galapagos Archipelago as being made of tuff that clearly flowed like mud, yet after solidifying, maintained a slope of twenty to even thirty degrees. The tuff doesn't wrap around the hills in continuous layers as it would if formed by the rising of horizontal layers. The author explains that the composition of the tuff is very similar to that of Monte Nuovo, and the steep angles at which the layers slope—both those that have flowed and those that have fallen as ashes—completely eliminate the issue that M. Dufrénoy proposed regarding the slope of Monte Nuovo, where it exceeds an angle of 18° to 20°. 512 Mr. Dana, in his account of the Sandwich Islands,513 also shows that in the "cinder cones" of that area, the layers originally incline between 35° and 40°, while in the "tufa cones" formed near the sea, the beds slope at about 30°. This naturalist also noted in the Samoan or Navigator Islands in Polynesia, that pieces of fresh coral had been ejected along with volcanic material to a height of 200 feet above sea level in tufa cones.514

I shall again revert to the doctrine of the origin of volcanic cones by upheaval, when speaking of Vesuvius, Etna, and Santorin, and shall now merely add, that, in 1538, the whole coast, from Monte Nuovo to beyond Puzzuoli, was upraised to the height of many feet above the bed of the Mediterranean, and has since retained the greater part of the elevation then acquired. The proofs of these remarkable changes of level will be considered at length when the phenomena of the temple of Serapis are described.515

I will revisit the idea of how volcanic cones are formed by uplift when discussing Vesuvius, Etna, and Santorin. For now, I’ll just mention that in 1538, the entire coastline, from Monte Nuovo to beyond Puzzuoli, was raised several feet above the Mediterranean Sea level and has retained most of that elevation since. The evidence of these significant changes in elevation will be discussed in detail when we describe the phenomena related to the temple of Serapis.515

373 Volcanoes of the Phlegræan Fields.—Immediately adjoining Monte Nuovo is the larger volcanic cone of Monte Barbaro (2, fig. 43, p. 367), the "Gaurus inanis" of Juvenal—an appellation given to it probably from its deep circular crater, which is about a mile in diameter. Large as is this cone, it was probably produced by a single eruption; and it does not, perhaps, exceed in magnitude some of the largest of those formed in Ischia, within the historical era. It is composed chiefly of indurated tufa like Monte Nuovo, stratified conformably to its conical surface. This hill was once very celebrated for its wines, and is still covered with vineyards; but when the vine is not in leaf it has a sterile appearance, and, late in the year, when seen from the beautiful Bay of Baiæ, it often contrasts so strongly in verdure with Monte Nuovo, which is always clothed with arbutus, myrtle, and other wild evergreens, that a stranger might well imagine the cone of older date to be that thrown up in the sixteenth century.516

373 Volcanoes of the Phlegræan Fields.—Right next to Monte Nuovo is the larger volcanic cone of Monte Barbaro (2, fig. 43, p. 367), the "Gaurus inanis" mentioned by Juvenal—likely named for its deep circular crater, which is about a mile wide. Despite its size, this cone was probably formed by a single eruption and doesn't seem to be much larger than some of the biggest ones created in Ischia during recorded history. It's mainly made of hardened tufa like Monte Nuovo, layered in line with its conical shape. This hill was once famous for its wines and still has many vineyards; however, when the vines aren't in leaf, it looks quite barren. Later in the year, when viewed from the stunning Bay of Baiæ, it often stands out sharply in greenery compared to Monte Nuovo, which is always covered with arbutus, myrtle, and other wild evergreen plants, leading a visitor to think that the older cone might be the one that erupted in the sixteenth century.516

There is nothing, indeed, so calculated to instruct the geologist as the striking manner in which the recent volcanic hills of Ischia, and that now under consideration, blend with the surrounding landscape. Nothing seems wanting or redundant; every part of the picture is in such perfect harmony with the rest, that the whole has the appearance of having been called into existence by a single effort of creative power. Yet what other result could we have anticipated if nature has ever been governed by the same laws? Each new mountain thrown up—each new tract of land raised or depressed by earthquakes—should be in perfect accordance with those previously formed, if the entire configuration of the surface has been due to a long series of similar disturbances. Were it true that the greater part of the dry land originated simultaneously in its present state, at some era of paroxysmal convulsion, and that additions were afterwards made slowly and successively during a period of comparative repose; then, indeed, there might be reason to expect a strong line of demarcation between the signs of the ancient and modern changes. But the very continuity of the plan, and the perfect identity of the causes, are to many a source of deception; since by producing a unity of effect, they lead them to exaggerate the energy of the agents which operated in the earlier ages. In the absence of all historical information, they are as unable to separate the dates of the origin of different portions of our continents, as the stranger is to determine, by their physical features alone, the distinct ages of Monte Nuovo, Monte Barbara, Astroni, and the Solfatara.

There’s nothing quite like the impressive way the recent volcanic hills of Ischia, along with the one we’re discussing, merge with the surrounding landscape to educate a geologist. Everything fits perfectly; nothing feels out of place or excessive. Each element of the scene harmonizes with the others, making it look like it was all created in one powerful moment of creative force. But what other outcome could we have expected if nature has always followed the same rules? Every new mountain that forms—every new piece of land that rises or falls because of earthquakes—should align perfectly with what was there before if the overall shape of the land has come from a long series of similar events. If it were true that most of the dry land appeared at the same time in its current form due to a massive upheaval, and that changes occurred slowly and steadily during quieter times, then we would indeed expect a clear line between signs of ancient and modern changes. However, the very continuity of the design and the complete similarity of the causes can mislead many people; the unity of effect makes them exaggerate the intensity of the forces that acted in earlier times. Without any historical records, they can’t distinguish the origins of different parts of our continents any more than a stranger can tell, based on physical characteristics alone, the specific ages of Monte Nuovo, Monte Barbara, Astroni, and the Solfatara.

The vast scale and violence of the volcanic operations in Campania, in the olden time, has been a theme of declamation, and has been contrasted with the comparative state of quiescence of this delightful region in the modern era. Instead of inferring, from analogy, that the ancient Vesuvius was always at rest when the craters of the Phlegræan Fields 374 were burning—that each cone rose in succession,—and that many years, and often centuries, of repose intervened between different eruptions,—geologists seem to have generally conjectured that the whole group sprung up from the ground at once, like the soldiers of Cadmus when he sowed the dragon's teeth. As well might they endeavor to persuade us that on these Phlegræan Fields, as the poets feigned, the giants warred with Jove, ere yet the puny race of mortals were in being.

The massive scale and violence of the volcanic activity in Campania in ancient times has been a popular topic of discussion, especially when compared to the relatively calm nature of this beautiful region today. Instead of assuming, based on comparisons, that ancient Vesuvius was always quiet while the craters of the Phlegræan Fields were active—that each cone erupted one after the other—and that many years, often centuries, of dormancy occurred between different eruptions, geologists generally speculate that the entire group formed all at once, like the warriors of Cadmus springing up from the ground when he sowed the dragon's teeth. They might as well try to convince us that, on these Phlegræan Fields, as the poets claimed, the giants fought with Jove before the feeble race of mortals even existed.

Modern eruptions of Vesuvius.—For nearly a century after the birth of Monte Nuovo, Vesuvius continued in a state of tranquillity. There had been no violent eruption for 492 years; and it appears that the crater was then exactly in the condition of the present extinct volcano of Astroni, near Naples. Bracini, who visited Vesuvius not long before the eruption of 1631, gives the following interesting description of the interior:—"The crater was five miles in circumference, and about a thousand paces deep: its sides were covered with brushwood, and at the bottom there was a plain on which cattle grazed. In the woody parts wild boars frequently harbored. In one part of the plain, covered with ashes, were three small pools, one filled with hot and bitter water, another salter than the sea, and a third hot, but tasteless."517 But at length these forests and grassy plains were consumed, being suddenly blown into the air, and their ashes scattered to the winds. In December, 1631, seven streams of lava poured at once from the crater, and overflowed several villages, on the flanks and at the foot of the mountain. Resina, partly built over the ancient site of Herculaneum, was consumed by the fiery torrent. Great floods of mud were as destructive as the lava itself,—no uncommon occurrence during these catastrophes; for such is the violence of rains produced by the evolutions of aqueous vapor, that torrents of water descend the cone, and becoming charged with impalpable volcanic dust, and rolling along loose ashes, acquire sufficient consistency to deserve their ordinary appellation of "aqueous lavas."

Modern eruptions of Vesuvius.—For nearly a century after Monte Nuovo was formed, Vesuvius stayed quiet. There had been no major eruptions for 492 years, and it seems the crater was in the same state as the current dormant volcano of Astroni, near Naples. Bracini, who visited Vesuvius shortly before the 1631 eruption, provided this intriguing description of the interior:—"The crater was five miles around and about a thousand paces deep; its walls were covered in brush, and at the bottom, there was a plain where cattle grazed. In the wooded areas, wild boars often took refuge. In one part of the ashy plain, there were three small pools: one filled with hot, bitter water, another saltier than the sea, and a third that was hot but tasteless."517 But eventually, these forests and grassy plains were destroyed, suddenly blown into the air, with their ashes swept away by the winds. In December 1631, seven streams of lava erupted simultaneously from the crater, flooding several villages on the slopes and at the base of the mountain. Resina, built partly over the ancient site of Herculaneum, was engulfed by the fiery flow. Massive mudflows were just as devastating as the lava itself—this is not uncommon during such disasters; the intense rains caused by the release of water vapor create torrents that rush down the slope, picking up volcanic dust and loose ashes, giving them enough substance to be called "aqueous lavas."

A brief period of repose ensued, which lasted only until the year 1666, from which time to the present there has been a constant series of eruptions, with rarely an interval of rest exceeding ten years. During these three centuries, no irregular volcanic agency has convulsed other points in this district. Brieslak remarked, that such irregular convulsions had occurred in the Bay of Naples in every second century; as, for example, the eruption of the Solfatara, in the twelfth; of the lava of Arso, in Ischia, in the fourteenth; and of Monte Nuovo in the sixteenth; but the eighteenth has formed an exception to this rule, and this seems accounted for by the unprecedented number of eruptions of Vesuvius during that period; whereas, when the new vents opened, there had always been, as we have seen, a long intermittence of activity in the principal volcano.

A short period of rest followed, lasting only until 1666, after which there has been a continuous series of eruptions, with few breaks longer than ten years. During these three centuries, no unusual volcanic activity has disturbed other areas in this region. Brieslak noted that such irregular eruptions happened in the Bay of Naples every other century; for example, the eruption of Solfatara in the twelfth century, the lava flow from Arso in Ischia in the fourteenth, and Monte Nuovo in the sixteenth. However, the eighteenth century was an exception to this pattern, likely due to the unprecedented number of eruptions at Vesuvius during that time. Whenever new vents opened, there had always been, as we have seen, a long period of inactivity in the main volcano.


CHAPTER XXIV.

VOLCANIC DISTRICT OF NAPLES—continued.

Dimensions and structure of the cone of Vesuvius—Fluidity and motion of lava—Dikes—Alluviums called "aqueous lavas"—Origin and composition of the matter enveloping Herculaneum and Pompeii—Condition and contents of the buried cities—Small number of skeletons—State of preservation of animal and vegetable substances—Rolls of papyrus—Stabiæ—Torre del Greco—Concluding remarks on the Campanian volcanoes.

Dimensions and structure of the cone of Vesuvius—Fluidity and movement of lava—Dikes—Alluvial deposits known as "aqueous lavas"—Origin and composition of the materials surrounding Herculaneum and Pompeii—Condition and contents of the buried cities—Limited number of skeletons—State of preservation of animal and plant materials—Rolls of papyrus—Stabiæ—Torre del Greco—Final thoughts on the Campanian volcanoes.

Structure of the cone of Vesuvius.—Between the end of the eighteenth century and the year 1822, the great crater of Vesuvius had been gradually filled by lava boiling up from below, and by scoriæ falling from the explosions of minor mouths which were formed at intervals on its bottom and sides. In place of a regular cavity, therefore, there was a rough and rocky plain, covered with blocks of lava and scoriæ, and cut by numerous fissures, from which clouds of vapor were evolved. But this state of things was totally changed by the eruption of October, 1822, when violent explosions, during the space of more than twenty days, broke up and threw out all this accumulated mass, so as to leave an immense gulf or chasm, of an irregular, but somewhat elliptical shape, about three miles in circumference when measured along the very sinuous and irregular line of its extreme margin, but somewhat less than three quarters of a mile in its longest diameter, which was directed from N. E. to S. W.518 The depth of this tremendous abyss has been variously estimated; for from the hour of its formation it increased daily by the dilapidation of its sides. It measured, at first, according to the account of some authors, two thousand feet in depth from the extreme part of the existing summit;519 but Mr. Scrope, when he saw it, soon after the eruption, estimated its depth at less than half that amount. More than eight hundred feet of the cone was carried away by the explosions, so that the mountain was reduced in height from about 4200 to 3400 feet.520

Structure of the cone of Vesuvius.—Between the end of the eighteenth century and the year 1822, the large crater of Vesuvius gradually filled with lava bubbling up from below and debris falling from explosions of smaller vents that formed at intervals on its bottom and sides. Instead of a regular cavity, there was a rough, rocky plain covered with blocks of lava and debris, marked by numerous fissures that released clouds of vapor. However, this situation changed dramatically with the eruption in October 1822, when violent explosions over more than twenty days shattered and expelled all this accumulated material, creating an immense gap or chasm, irregular but somewhat elliptical in shape, about three miles in circumference when measured along the very winding and uneven line of its outer edge, but just under three-quarters of a mile in its longest diameter, which extended from N.E. to S.W.518 The depth of this massive abyss has been estimated in various ways; from the moment it formed, it became deeper daily due to the crumbling of its sides. Initially, according to some authors, it measured two thousand feet deep from the extreme part of the existing summit;519 but Mr. Scrope, who saw it shortly after the eruption, estimated its depth to be less than half that amount. More than eight hundred feet of the cone was removed by the explosions, resulting in a decrease in the mountain's height from about 4200 to 3400 feet.520

As we ascend the sloping sides, the volcano appears a mass of loose materials—a mere heap of rubbish, thrown together without the slightest order; but on arriving at the brim of the crater, and obtaining a view of the interior, we are agreeably surprised to discover that the conformation of the whole displays in every part the most perfect symmetry and arrangement. The materials are disposed in regular strata, slightly undulating, appearing, when viewed in front, to be disposed in horizontal planes. But, as we make the circuit of the edge of the crater, 376 and observe the cliffs by which it is encircled projecting or receding in salient or retiring angles, we behold transverse sections of the currents of lava and beds of sand and scoriæ, and recognize their true dip. We then discover that they incline outwards from the axis of the cone, at angles varying from 30° to 40°. The whole cone, in fact, is composed of a number of concentric coatings of alternating lavas, sand, and scoriæ. Every shower of ashes which has fallen from above, and every stream of lava descending from the lips of the crater, have conformed to the outward surface of the hill, so that one conical envelope may be said to have been successively folded round another, until the aggregation of the whole mountain was completed. The marked separation into distinct beds results from the different colors and degrees of coarseness in the sands, scoriæ, and lava, and the alternation of these with each other. The greatest difficulty, on the first view, is to conceive how so much regularity can be produced, notwithstanding the unequal distribution of sand and scoriæ, driven by prevailing winds in particular eruptions, and the small breadth of each sheet of lava as it first flows out from the crater.

As we climb the sloping sides, the volcano looks like a mass of loose materials—a simple pile of debris, thrown together without any organization; but upon reaching the edge of the crater and looking inside, we are pleasantly surprised to find that its structure shows perfect symmetry and arrangement in every part. The materials are laid out in regular layers, slightly undulating, and when viewed from the front, they seem arranged in horizontal planes. However, as we walk around the rim of the crater, 376 and observe the cliffs surrounding it, jutting out or receding at angles, we see cross-sections of the lava flows and layers of sand and scoria, and we can understand their true slope. We then realize that they tilt outward from the center of the cone, at angles ranging from 30° to 40°. The entire cone is made up of several concentric layers of alternating lava, sand, and scoria. Every ash fall from above and every flow of lava from the crater's edge has followed the outward surface of the hill, effectively wrapping one conical layer around another until the entire mountain was formed. The clear separation into distinct layers comes from the different colors and textures of the sand, scoria, and lava, along with their alternation. The biggest challenge at first is to understand how such regularity can occur, despite the uneven distribution of sand and scoria, pushed by prevailing winds during specific eruptions, and the narrow width of each lava flow as it initially spills out from the crater.

But, on a closer examination, we find that the appearance of extreme uniformity is delusive; for when a number of beds thin out gradually, and at different points, the eye does not without difficulty recognize the termination of any one stratum, but usually supposes it continuous with some other, which at a short distance may lie precisely in the same plane. The slight undulations, moreover, produced by inequalities on the sides of the hill on which the successive layers were moulded, assist the deception. As countless beds of sand and scoriæ constitute the greater part of the whole mass, these may sometimes mantle continuously round the whole cone; and even lava streams may be of considerable breadth when first they overflow, and since, in some eruptions, a considerable part of the upper portion of the cone breaks down at once, may form a sheet extending as far as the space which the eye usually takes in, in a single section.

But if we take a closer look, we realize that the appearance of perfect uniformity is misleading; when a number of layers gradually thin out at different points, it can be hard to see where any one layer ends. Instead, we often assume it connects with another layer that may lie in the same plane just a short distance away. The slight undulations caused by variations on the hillsides where these layers formed contribute to the illusion. Since countless layers of sand and scoria make up most of the mass, they can sometimes wrap continuously around the entire cone. Even lava flows can be quite wide when they first spill over, and during some eruptions, a significant portion of the upper part of the cone can collapse all at once, creating a layer that stretches as far as the eye typically views in a single glance.

The high inclination of some of the beds, and the firm union of the particles even where there is evidently no cement, is another striking feature in the volcanic tuffs and breccias, which seems at first not very easy of explanation. But the last great eruption afforded ample illustration of the manner in which these strata are formed. Fragments of lava, scoriæ, pumice, and sand, when they fall at slight distances from the summit, are only half cooled down from a state of fusion, and are afterwards acted upon by the heat from within, and by fumeroles or small crevices in the cone through which hot vapors are disengaged. Thus heated, the ejected fragments cohere together strongly; and the whole mass acquires such consistency in a few days, that fragments cannot be detached without a smart blow of the hammer. At the same time sand and scoriæ, ejected to a greater distance, remain incoherent.521

The steep angle of some of the layers, along with the strong bond of the particles even where there’s clearly no cement, is another striking characteristic of the volcanic tuffs and breccias, which initially seems difficult to explain. However, the last major eruption provided a clear example of how these layers are created. Fragments of lava, scoria, pumice, and sand, when they fall from a short distance away from the summit, are only partially cooled from their molten state and are then influenced by the heat from below, as well as by fumeroles or small cracks in the cone that release hot vapors. When heated, the ejected fragments stick together tightly; and within a few days, the entire mass becomes so solid that pieces can't be removed without a strong hit from a hammer. Meanwhile, sand and scoria blown further away remain loose. 521

377 Sir William Hamilton, in his description of the eruption of 1779, says that jets of liquid lava, mixed with stones and scoriæ, were thrown up to the height of at least ten thousand feet, having the appearance of a column of fire.522 Some of these were directed by the winds towards Ottajano, and some of them falling almost perpendicularly, still red-hot and liquid, on Vesuvius, covered its whole cone, part of the mountain of Somma, and the valley between them. The falling matter being nearly as vividly inflamed as that which was continually issuing fresh from the crater, formed with it one complete body of fire, which could not be less than two miles and a half in breadth, and of the extraordinary height above mentioned, casting a heat to the distance of at least six miles round it. Dr. Clarke, also, in his account of the eruption of 1793, says that millions of red-hot stones were shot into the air full half the height of the cone itself, and then bending, fell all round in a fine arch. On another occasion he says that, as they fell, they covered nearly half the cone with fire.

377 Sir William Hamilton, describing the eruption of 1779, mentions that jets of liquid lava, mixed with stones and ash, shot up to at least ten thousand feet, resembling a column of fire.522 Some of these were blown by the winds towards Ottajano, while others fell almost straight down, still red-hot and liquid, on Vesuvius, covering its entire cone, part of the Somma mountain, and the valley between them. The falling debris was nearly as intensely ablaze as the continuous flow from the crater, creating one massive body of fire that was at least two and a half miles wide and reached the extraordinary height mentioned, radiating heat to a distance of at least six miles around it. Dr. Clarke, in his account of the eruption of 1793, states that millions of red-hot stones were launched into the air, reaching nearly half the height of the cone itself, and then arched down, landing all around. He also noted that as they fell, they covered almost half the cone in flames.

The same author has also described the different appearance of the lava at its source, and at some distance from it, when it had descended into the plains below. At the point where it issued, in 1793, from an arched chasm in the side of the mountain, the vivid torrent rushed with the velocity of a flood. It was in perfect fusion, unattended with any scoriæ on its surface, or any gross materials not in a state of complete solution. It flowed with the translucency of honey, "in regular channels, cut finer than art can imitate, and glowing with all the splendor of the sun."—"Sir William Hamilton," he continues, "had conceived that no stones thrown upon a current of lava would make any impression. I was soon convinced of the contrary. Light bodies, indeed, of five, ten, and fifteen pounds' weight, made little or no impression even at the source; but bodies of sixty, seventy, and eighty pounds were seen to form a kind of bed on the surface of the lava, and float away with it. A stone of three hundred weight, that had been thrown out by the crater, lay near the source of the current of lava: I raised it upon one end, and then let it fall in upon the liquid lava; when it gradually sunk beneath the surface, and disappeared. If I wished to describe the manner in which it acted upon the lava, I should say that it was like a loaf of bread thrown into a bowl of very thick honey, which gradually involves itself in the heavy liquid, and then slowly sinks to the bottom.

The same author has also described how lava looks at its source and further away after it has flowed into the plains below. When it burst forth in 1793 from an arched opening in the side of the mountain, the bright torrent rushed down like a flood. It was fully melted, with no scoria on its surface or any rough materials not fully dissolved. It flowed with a clarity like honey, "in regular channels, cut finer than art can imitate, and glowing with all the splendor of the sun."—"Sir William Hamilton," he continues, "thought that no stones thrown onto a current of lava would leave any mark. I quickly found that wasn’t true. Lighter objects, weighing five, ten, and fifteen pounds, barely left any mark even at the source; but objects weighing sixty, seventy, and eighty pounds formed a kind of bed on the surface of the lava and floated away with it. A stone weighing three hundred pounds, which had been ejected by the crater, was lying near the source of the lava current: I lifted it onto one end, then let it fall onto the liquid lava; it gradually sank beneath the surface and disappeared. If I wanted to describe how it interacted with the lava, I'd say it was like a loaf of bread tossed into a bowl of very thick honey, which slowly gets enveloped in the heavy liquid and then gradually sinks to the bottom.

"The lava, at a small distance from its source, acquires a darker tint upon its surface, is less easily acted upon, and, as the stream widens, the surface, having lost its state of perfect solution, grows harder and harder, and cracks into innumerable fragments of very porous matter, to which they give the name of scoriæ, and the appearance of which has led many to suppose that it proceeded thus from the mountain. There is, however, no truth in this. All lava, at its first exit from its 378 native volcano, flows out in a liquid state, and all equally in fusion. The appearance of the scoriæ is to be attributed only to the action of the external air, and not to any difference in the materials which compose it, since any lava whatever, separated from its channel, and exposed to the action of the external air, immediately cracks, becomes porous, and alters its form. As we proceeded downwards, this became more and more evident; and the same lava which at its original source flowed in perfect solution, undivided, and free from incumbrances of any kind, a little farther down had its surface loaded with scoriæ in such a manner, that, upon its arrival at the bottom of the mountain, the whole current resembled nothing so much as a heap of unconnected cinders from an iron-foundry." In another place he says that "the rivers of lava in the plain resembled a vast heap of cinders, or the scoriæ of an iron-foundry, rolling slowly along, and falling with a rattling noise over one another."523 Von Buch, who was in company with MM. de Humboldt and Gay-Lussac, describes the lava of 1805 (the most fluid on record) as shooting suddenly before their eyes from top to bottom of the cone in one single instant. Professor J. D. Forbes remarks that the length of the slope of the cone proper being about 1300 feet, this motion must correspond to a velocity of many hundred feet in a few seconds, without interpreting Von Buch's expression literally. The same lava, when it reached the level road at Torre del Greco, moved at the rate of only eighteen inches per minute, or three-tenths of an inch per second.524 "Although common lava," observes Professor Forbes, "is nearly as liquid as melted iron, when it issues from the orifice of the crater, its fluidity rapidly diminishes, and as it becomes more and more burdened by the consolidated slag through which it has to force its way, its velocity of motion diminishes in an almost inconceivable degree; and at length, when it ceases to present the slightest external trace of fluidity, its movement can only be ascertained by careful and repeated observations, just as in the case of a glacier."525

"The lava, when it's a little way from its source, takes on a darker color on its surface, is less affected by outside forces, and as the flow spreads out, it loses its perfect liquid state, becomes harder and harder, and breaks into countless fragments of very porous material, which are called scoria. The way these look has led many to think they came straight from the mountain. However, that's not true. All lava, when it first erupts from its native volcano, flows out in a liquid state and is all equally molten. The appearance of scoria is just due to the action of the air, not because of any difference in the materials, since any lava, when separated from its flow and exposed to the air, cracks, becomes porous, and changes shape. As we moved downward, this became clearer; the same lava that originally flowed in a perfect liquid state, uninterrupted and free of any debris, farther down had its surface covered with scoria to such an extent that by the time it reached the bottom of the mountain, the entire flow looked like a pile of loose cinders from an iron foundry." In another place, he says that "the rivers of lava in the plain looked like a massive pile of cinders, or the scoria from an iron-foundry, slowly rolling along and clattering over one another." Von Buch, who was with MM. de Humboldt and Gay-Lussac, describes the lava of 1805 (the most fluid ever recorded) as shooting suddenly before them from the top to the bottom of the cone in an instant. Professor J. D. Forbes notes that the slope of the cone is about 1300 feet, so this motion must equate to a speed of several hundred feet in a matter of seconds, without taking Von Buch's words to be taken too literally. When the same lava reached the flat road at Torre del Greco, it moved at a pace of only eighteen inches per minute, or three-tenths of an inch per second. "Although typical lava," says Professor Forbes, "is almost as liquid as melted iron when it first pours out of the crater, its fluidity decreases quickly, and as it gets more and more burdened by the solidified slag it has to push through, its speed diminishes dramatically; and eventually, when it shows no signs of being fluid at all, its movement can only be determined through careful and repeated observations, much like with a glacier."

It appears that the intensity of the light and heat of the lava varies considerably at different periods of the same eruption, as in that of Vesuvius in 1819 and 1820, when Sir H. Davy remarked different degrees of vividness in the white heat at the point where the lava originated.526

It seems that the brightness and temperature of the lava changes a lot at different times during the same eruption, like in Vesuvius in 1819 and 1820, when Sir H. Davy noted various levels of brightness in the white-hot lava at its source.526

When the expressions "flame" and "smoke" are used in describing volcanic appearances, they must generally be understood in a figurative sense. We are informed, indeed, by M. Abich, that he distinctly saw, in the eruption of Vesuvius in 1834, the flame of burning hydrogen;527 but what is usually mistaken for flame consists of vapor or scoriæ, and impalpable dust illuminated by that vivid light which is emitted from the crater below, where the lava is said to glow with the splendor of 379 the sun. The clouds of apparent smoke are formed either of aqueous and other vapor, or of finely comminuted scoriæ.

When we talk about "flame" and "smoke" in relation to volcanoes, we usually mean them in a figurative way. M. Abich reported that he clearly witnessed the flame of burning hydrogen during the eruption of Vesuvius in 1834;527 but what people often mistake for flame is actually vapor or scoria, along with tiny particles of dust that are lit up by the bright light coming from the crater below, where the lava is said to shine as brilliantly as the sun. The clouds that look like smoke are made up of water vapor and other gases, or finely ground scoria.

Dikes in the recent cone, how formed.—The inclined strata before mentioned which dip outwards in all directions from the axis of the cone of Vesuvius, are intersected by veins or dikes of compact lava, for the most part in a vertical position. In 1828 these were seen to be about seven in number, some of them not less than four or five hundred feet in height, and thinning out before they reached the uppermost part of the cone. Being harder than the beds through which they pass, they have decomposed less rapidly, and therefore stand out in relief. When I visited Vesuvius, in November, 1828, I was prevented from descending into the crater by the constant ejections then thrown out; so that I got sight of three only of the dikes; but Signor Monticelli had previously had drawings made of the whole, which he showed me. The dikes which I saw were on that side of the cone which is encircled by Somma. The eruption before mentioned, of 1828, began in March, and in the November following the ejected matter had filled up nearly one-third of the deep abyss formed at the close of the eruption of 1822. In November I found a single black cone at the bottom of the crater continually throwing out scoriæ, while on the exterior of the cone I observed the lava of 1822, which had flowed out six years before, not yet cool, and still evolving much heat and vapor from crevices.

Dikes in the recent cone, how formed.—The inclined layers I mentioned earlier, which slope outward in all directions from the center of the Vesuvius cone, are intersected by veins or dikes of solid lava, mostly standing vertically. In 1828, there were around seven of these dikes, with some reaching heights of four or five hundred feet and tapering off before they reached the top of the cone. Since they are harder than the surrounding rock, they have worn down less quickly and therefore stand out. When I visited Vesuvius in November 1828, I couldn't go into the crater because of the continuous eruptions at that time; so, I only saw three of the dikes. However, Signor Monticelli had made drawings of all of them, which he showed me. The dikes I did see were on the side of the cone that is surrounded by Somma. The previously mentioned eruption of 1828 started in March, and by the following November, the erupted material had nearly filled one-third of the deep pit created by the eruption in 1822. In November, I noted a single black cone at the bottom of the crater continuously spewing out scoria, while on the outside of the cone, I observed the lava from 1822, which had flowed out six years earlier, still not cool and emitting a lot of heat and vapor from cracks.

Hoffmann, in 1832, saw on the north side of Vesuvius, near the peak called Palo, a great many parallel bands of lava, some from six to eight feet thick, alternating with scoriæ and conglomerate. These beds, he says, were cut through by many dikes, some of them five feet broad. They resemble those of Somma, the stone being composed of grains of leucite and augite.528

Hoffmann, in 1832, observed on the north side of Vesuvius, close to the peak known as Palo, numerous parallel bands of lava, some measuring six to eight feet thick, alternating with scoria and conglomerate. He noted that these layers were intersected by several dikes, some as wide as five feet. They are similar to those found in Somma, with the rock made up of grains of leucite and augite.528

There can be no doubt that the dikes above mentioned have been produced by the filling up of open fissures with liquid lava; but of the date of their formation we know nothing farther than that they are all subsequent to the year 79, and, relatively speaking, that they are more modern than all the lavas and scoriæ which they intersect. A considerable number of the upper strata are not traversed by them. That the earthquakes, which almost invariably precede eruptions, occasion rents in the mass, is well known; and, in 1822, three months before the lava flowed out, open fissures, evolving hot vapors, were numerous. It is clear that such rents must be ejected with melted matter when the column of lava rises, so that the origin of the dikes is easily explained, as also the great solidity and crystalline nature of the rock composing them, which has been formed by lava cooling slowly under great pressure.

There’s no doubt that the dikes mentioned earlier were created by open fissures being filled with liquid lava; however, we don't know exactly when they formed except that it was after the year 79, and they are relatively more recent than all the lavas and scoria they cut through. Many of the upper layers aren’t affected by them. It’s well known that the earthquakes that almost always happen before eruptions cause cracks in the rock. In 1822, three months before the lava began flowing, there were many open fissures releasing hot vapors. It’s clear that these cracks must have been expelled along with the molten rock when the lava column rose, making the origin of the dikes easy to understand, as well as the strong, crystalline nature of the rock that makes them up, which formed from lava cooling slowly under heavy pressure.

It has been suggested that the frequent rending of volcanic cones during eruptions may be connected with the gradual and successive upheaval of the whole mass in such a manner as to increase the inclination of the beds composing the cone; and in accordance with the 380 hypothesis before proposed for the origin of Monte Nuovo, Von Buch supposes that the present cone of Vesuvius was formed in the year 79, not by eruption, but by upheaval. It was not produced by the repeated superposition of scoriæ and lava cast out or flowing from a central source, but by the uplifting of strata previously horizontal. The entire cone rose at once, such as we now see it, from the interior and middle of Somma, and has since received no accession of height, but, on the contrary, has ever since been diminishing in elevation.529

It has been suggested that the frequent tearing apart of volcanic cones during eruptions might be linked to the gradual and successive uplifting of the entire mass, which increases the slope of the layers making up the cone. In line with the hypothesis previously proposed regarding the formation of Monte Nuovo, Von Buch theorizes that the current cone of Vesuvius was created in the year 79, not by eruption, but through uplift. It wasn't formed by the repeated layering of scoria and lava expelled or flowing from a central source, but by raising previously horizontal layers. The whole cone lifted simultaneously, as we see it now, from the interior and center of Somma and has not gained any height since; on the contrary, it has been gradually decreasing in elevation.380529

Although I consider this hypothesis of Von Buch to be quite untenable, I may mention some facts which may at first sight seem to favor it. These are recorded by M. Abich in his account of the Vesuvian eruptions of 1833 and 1834, a work illustrated by excellent engravings of the volcanic phenomena which he witnessed.530 It appears that, in the year 1834, the great crater of Vesuvius had been filled up nearly to the top with lava, which had consolidated and formed a level and unbroken plain, except that a small cone thrown up by the ejection of scoriæ rose in the middle of it like an island in a lake. At length this plain of lava was broken by a fissure which passed from N. E. to S. W., and along this line a great number of minute cones emitting vapor were formed. The first act of formation of these minor cones is said to have consisted of a partial upheaval of beds of lava previously horizontal, and which had been rendered flexible by the heat and tension of elastic fluids, which, rising from below, escaped from the centre of each new monticule. There would be considerable analogy between this mode of origin and that ascribed by Von Buch to Vesuvius and Somma, if the dimensions of the upraised masses were not on so different a scale, and if it was safe to reason from the inflation of bladders of half-fused lava, from fifteen to twenty-five feet in height, to mountains attaining an altitude of several thousand feet, and having their component strata strengthened by intersecting dikes of solid lava.

Although I find Von Buch's hypothesis to be pretty unconvincing, I should mention some facts that might initially seem to support it. These are documented by M. Abich in his account of the Vesuvian eruptions of 1833 and 1834, a work enhanced by excellent engravings of the volcanic phenomena he observed.530 In 1834, the main crater of Vesuvius was almost completely filled with lava, which had hardened into a flat, uninterrupted plain, except for a small cone created by the ejection of scoria that rose in the center like an island in a lake. Eventually, this lava plain was disrupted by a fissure that stretched from northeast to southwest, along which many tiny cones emitting vapor formed. The initial formation of these smaller cones is said to have involved some uplift of previously horizontal lava beds, which had become pliable due to the heat and pressure of gases coming from below that escaped from the center of each new mound. There would be a significant similarity between this process and the one Von Buch attributed to Vesuvius and Somma, if the sizes of the raised masses weren't so different, and if it were reasonable to compare the inflation of gas-filled blobs of semi-fused lava, from fifteen to twenty-five feet tall, to mountains reaching several thousand feet in height and having their layers reinforced by intersecting dikes of solid lava.

At the same time M. Abich mentions, that when, in August, 1834, a great subsidence took place in the platform of lava within the great crater, so that the structure of the central cone was laid open, it was seen to have been evidently formed, not by upheaval, but by the fall of cinders and scoriæ which had been thrown out during successive eruptions.531

At the same time, M. Abich notes that when a significant collapse occurred in the lava platform within the large crater in August 1834, revealing the structure of the central cone, it was clear that it had been formed, not by rising up, but by the fall of cinders and scoria that had been ejected during multiple eruptions.531

Previous to the year 79, Vesuvius appears, from the description of its figure given by Strabo, to have been a truncated cone, having a level and even outline as seen from a distance. That it had a crater on its summit, we may infer from a passage in Plutarch, on which Dr. Daubeny has judiciously commented in his treatise on volcanoes.532 The walls of the crater were evidently entire, except on one side, where there was a single narrow breach. When Spartacus, in the year 72, encamped his 381 gladiators in this hollow, Clodius, the prætor, besieged him there, keeping the single outlet carefully guarded, and then let down his soldiers by scaling-ladders over the steep precipices which surrounded the crater, at the bottom of which the insurgents were encamped. On the side towards the sea, the walls of this original cavity, which must have been three miles in diameter, have been destroyed, and Brieslak was the first to announce the opinion, that this destruction happened during the tremendous eruption which occurred in 79, when the new cone, now called Vesuvius, was thrown up, which stands encircled on three sides by the ruins of the ancient cone, called Monte Somma.

Before the year 79, Vesuvius seems, based on Strabo's description of its shape, to have been a truncated cone with a flat and even outline when viewed from a distance. We can infer that it had a crater at its summit from a passage in Plutarch, which Dr. Daubeny has wisely commented on in his work about volcanoes.532 The walls of the crater were clearly intact except on one side, where there was a narrow opening. When Spartacus set up camp in this hollow with his gladiators in 72, Clodius, the praetor, laid siege to him there, carefully guarding the only exit. He lowered his soldiers over the steep cliffs surrounding the crater using scaling ladders, where the insurgents were camped at the bottom. On the side facing the sea, the walls of this original cavity, which must have been about three miles in diameter, have been destroyed. Brieslak was the first to suggest that this destruction occurred during the massive eruption in 79, when the new cone, now known as Vesuvius, was formed, which is surrounded on three sides by the remains of the ancient cone, known as Monte Somma.

Fig. 45.Supposed section of Vesuvius and Somma.

Supposed section of Vesuvius and Somma.

Supposed section of Vesuvius and Somma.

a, Monte Somma, or the remains of the ancient cone of Vesuvius.

a, Monte Somma, or what's left of the old cone of Vesuvius.

b, The Pedamentina, a terrace-like projection, encircling the base of the recent cone of Vesuvius on the south side.

b, The Pedamentina, a terrace-like projection, wrapping around the base of the newly formed cone of Vesuvius on the south side.

c, Atrio del Cavallo.533

c, Horse Atrium.533

d, e, Crater left by eruption of 1822.

d, e, Crater caused by the eruption in 1822.

f, Small cone thrown up in 1828, at the bottom of the great crater.

f, Small cone erupted in 1828, at the base of the large crater.

g, g, Dikes intersecting Somma.

g, g, Dikes crossing Somma.

h, h, Dikes intersecting the recent cone of Vesuvius.

h, h, Dikes crossing the recent cone of Vesuvius.

In the annexed diagram (fig. 45) it will be seen that on the side of Vesuvius opposite to that where a portion of the ancient cone of Somma (a) still remains, is a projection (b) called the Pedamentina, which some have supposed to be part of the circumference of the ancient crater broken down towards the sea, and over the edge of which the lavas of the modern Vesuvius have poured; the axis of the present cone of Vesuvius being, according to Visconti, precisely equidistant from the escarpment of Somma and the Pedamentina.

In the diagram (fig. 45), you can see that on the side of Vesuvius opposite the section of the ancient cone of Somma (a) that still exists, there is a projection (b) known as the Pedamentina. Some people believe this is part of the edge of the ancient crater that collapsed toward the sea, over which the lava from modern Vesuvius has flowed. According to Visconti, the axis of the current Vesuvius cone is exactly equidistant from both the escarpment of Somma and the Pedamentina.

In the same diagram I have represented the slanting beds of the cone of Vesuvius as becoming horizontal in the Atrio del Cavallo (at c), where the base of the new cone meets the precipitous escarpment of Somma; for when the lava flows down to this point, as happened in 1822, its descending course is arrested, and it then runs in another direction along this small valley, circling round the base of the cone. Sand and scoriæ, also, blown by the winds, collect at the base of the cone, and are then swept away by torrents; so that there is always here a flatish plain, as represented. In the same manner, the small 382 interior cone (f) must be composed of sloping beds, terminating in a horizontal plain; for, while this monticule was gradually gaining height by successive ejections of lava and scoriæ, in 1828, it was always surrounded by a flat pool of semi-fluid lava, into which scoriæ and sand were thrown.

In the same diagram, I have shown how the slanted layers of the Vesuvius cone become horizontal at the Atrio del Cavallo (at c), where the base of the new cone meets the steep cliff of Somma. When the lava flows down to this point, like it did in 1822, its downward movement stops, and it then flows in a different direction through this small valley, wrapping around the base of the cone. Sand and ash, also blown by the winds, accumulate at the base of the cone and are then washed away by floods; so there is always a relatively flat plain here, as depicted. Similarly, the small 382 interior cone (f) must consist of sloping layers that end in a flat plain; because while this mound gradually grew taller from repeated eruptions of lava and ash in 1828, it was always surrounded by a level pool of semi-liquid lava, into which ash and sand were deposited.

In the steep simicircular escarpment of Somma, which faces the modern Vesuvius, we see a great number of sheets of lava inclined at an angle of about 26°. They alternate with scoriæ, and are intersected by numerous dikes, which, like the sheets of lava, are composed chiefly of augite, with crystals of leucite, but the rock in the dikes is more compact, having cooled and consolidated under greater pressure. Some of the dikes cut through and shift others, so that they have evidently been formed during successive eruptions. While the higher region of Somma is made up of these igneous products, there appear on its flanks, for some depth from the surface, as seen in a ravine called the "Fossa Grande," beds of white pumiceous tuff, resembling the tuff which, at Pausilippo, and other places, near Naples, contain shells of living Mediterranean species. It is supposed by Pilla, Von Buch, and others, that the tufaceous beds, which rise in Somma to more than half the height of that mountain, are, in like manner, of submarine origin, because a few sea-shells have been found in them, here and there, together with serpulæ of recent species attached to included blocks of limestone.534

In the steep semicircular slope of Somma, which faces the modern Vesuvius, we see a large number of sheets of lava tilted at about a 26° angle. They alternate with scoria and are crossed by many dikes, which, like the lava sheets, are mainly made of augite, with crystals of leucite. However, the rock in the dikes is more solid because it cooled and hardened under greater pressure. Some of the dikes cut through and displace others, indicating that they were formed during different eruptions. While the upper part of Somma consists of these volcanic products, its slopes, at a depth from the surface, display beds of white pumiceous tuff, similar to the tuff found in Pausilippo and other areas near Naples that contain shells of living Mediterranean species. Pilla, Von Buch, and others suggest that the tuff beds, which rise up to more than half the height of the mountain, likely have a submarine origin because a few sea-shells have been discovered in them, along with recent species of serpulæ attached to included limestone blocks.534

It is contended, therefore, that as these strata were once accumulated beneath the sea, they may have been subjected as they rose to such an upward movement as may have given rise to a conical hill; and this hypothesis, it is said, acquires confirmation from the fact, that the sheets of lava near the summit of Somma are so compact and crystalline, and of such breadth individually, as would not have been the case had they run down a steep slope. They must, therefore, have consolidated on a nearly level surface, and have been subsequently uplifted into their present inclined position.

It is argued, then, that since these layers were once formed beneath the sea, they may have experienced an upward movement as they rose which could have created a conical hill. This theory is supported by the observation that the layers of lava near the top of Somma are very dense and crystalline, and individually quite wide, which wouldn’t have happened if they had flowed down a steep slope. Therefore, they must have solidified on a nearly flat surface and were later pushed up into their current tilted position.

Unfortunately there are no sections of sufficient depth and continuity on the flanks of Somma, to reveal to us clearly the relations of the lava, scoriæ, and associated dikes, forming the highest part of the mountain, with the marine tuffs observed on its declivity. Both may, perhaps, have been produced contemporaneously when Somma raised its head, like Stromboli, above the sea, its sides and base being then submerged. Such a state of things may be indicated by a fact noticed by Von Buch, namely, that the pumiceous beds of Naples, when they approach Somma, contain fragments of the peculiar leucitic lava proper to that mountain, which are not found in the same tuff at a greater distance.535 Portions, therefore, of this lava were either thrown 383 out by explosions, or torn off by the waves, during the deposition of the pumiceous strata beneath the sea.

Unfortunately, there are no sections of enough depth and continuity on the sides of Somma to clearly show us the relationships between the lava, scoria, and associated dikes that make up the highest part of the mountain and the marine tuffs seen on its slope. Both may have possibly formed at the same time when Somma rose above the sea, similar to Stromboli, with its sides and base still submerged. This situation might be supported by a point made by Von Buch, that the pumice beds near Naples, as they approach Somma, contain pieces of the unique leucitic lava specific to that mountain, which aren’t present in the same tuff further away.535 Therefore, some of this lava was either ejected in explosions or broken off by the waves during the formation of the pumiceous layers under the sea.

We have as yet but a scanty acquaintance with the laws which regulate the flow of lava beneath water, or the arrangement of scoriæ and volcanic dust on the sides of a submarine cone. There can, however, be little doubt that showers of ejected matter may settle on a steep slope, and may include shells and the remains of aquatic animals, which flourish in the intervals between eruptions. Lava under the pressure of water would be less porous; but, as Dr. Daubeny suggests, it may retain its fluidity longer than in the open air; for the rapidity with which heated bodies are cooled by being plunged into water arises chiefly from the conversion of the lower portions of water into steam, which steam absorbing much heat, immediately ascends, and is reconverted into water. But under the pressure of a deep ocean, the heat of the lava would be carried off more slowly, and only by the circulation of ascending and descending currents of water, those portions nearest the source of heat becoming specifically light, and consequently displacing the water above. This kind of circulation would take place with much less rapidity than in the atmosphere, inasmuch as the expansion of water by equal increments of heat is less considerable than that of air.536

We still have a limited understanding of the laws that govern the flow of lava underwater or how volcanic rocks and dust are arranged on the slopes of an underwater cone. However, it's clear that eruptions can send material down a steep slope, and this material may include shells and remains of aquatic animals that thrive in the periods between eruptions. Lava under water pressure would be less porous, but, as Dr. Daubeny suggests, it might stay fluid longer than it does in the open air. The rapid cooling of heated materials when they are submerged in water mainly happens because the lower layers of water turn into steam, which absorbs a lot of heat and rises, then turns back into water. In the depths of the ocean, however, the lava's heat would disperse more slowly, relying on the movement of rising and falling water currents. The areas closest to the heat source would become lighter and push the water above them aside. This circulation would occur much more slowly than it does in the air because the expansion of water with equal amounts of heat is less significant than that of air.536

We learn from the valuable observations made by Mr. Dana on the active volcanoes of the Sandwich Islands, that large sheets of compact basaltic lava have been poured out of craters at the top or near the summits of flattened domes higher than Etna, as in the case of Mount Loa for example, where a copious stream two miles broad and twenty-five miles long proceeded from an opening 13,000 feet above the level of the sea. The usual slope of these sheets of lava is between 5° and 10°; but Mr. Dana convinced himself that, owing to the suddenness with which they cool in the air, some lavas may occasionally form on slopes equalling 25°, and still preserve a considerable compactness of texture. It is even proved, he says, from what he saw in the great lateral crater of Kilauea, on the flanks of Mount Loa, that a mass of such melted rock may consolidate at an inclination of 30°, and be continuous for 300 or 400 feet. Such masses are narrow, he admits, "but if the source had been more generous, they would have had a greater breadth, and by a succession of ejections overspreading each cooled layer, a considerable thickness might have been attained."537 The same author has also shown, as before mentioned, that in the "cinder cones" of the Sandwich Islands, the strata have an original inclination of between 35° and 40°.538

We learn from the insightful observations made by Mr. Dana on the active volcanoes of the Sandwich Islands that large sheets of solid basaltic lava have erupted from craters at the top or near the peaks of flattened domes higher than Etna. For example, in the case of Mount Loa, a massive flow two miles wide and twenty-five miles long emerged from an opening 13,000 feet above sea level. The typical slope of these lava sheets is between 5° and 10°, but Mr. Dana found that, due to how quickly they cool in the air, some lavas can sometimes form on slopes as steep as 25° while still maintaining a fairly compact texture. He even observed in the large lateral crater of Kilauea, on the slopes of Mount Loa, that a mass of such melted rock can solidify at a 30° angle and stretch continuously for 300 or 400 feet. These masses are narrow, he acknowledges, "but if the source had been more generous, they would have had a greater width, and through a series of eruptions covering each cooled layer, a significant thickness could have been achieved." 537 The same author has also demonstrated, as mentioned earlier, that in the "cinder cones" of the Sandwich Islands, the layers have an original incline of between 35° and 40°. 538

Mr. Scrope, writing in 1827, attributed the formation of a volcanic cone chiefly to matter ejected from a central orifice, but partly to the injection of lava into dikes, and "to that force of gaseous expansion, the 384 intensity of which, in the central parts of the cone, is attested by local earthquakes, which so often accompany eruptions.539 It is the opinion of MM. Von Buch, De Beaumont, and Dufrénoy, that the sheets of lava on Somma are so uniform and compact, that their original inclination did not exceed four or five degrees, and that four-fifths, therefore, of their present slope is due to their having been subsequently tilted and upraised. Notwithstanding the light thrown by M. de Beaumont on the laws regulating the flow and consolidation of lava, I do not conceive that these laws are as yet sufficiently determined to warrant us in assigning so much of the inclined position of the beds of Somma to the subsequent rending and dislocation of the cone. Even if this were admitted, it is far more in harmony with the usual mode of development of volcanic forces to suppose the movement which modified the shape of the cone to have been intermittent and gradual, and not to have consisted of a single effort, or one sudden and violent convulsion.540

Mr. Scrope, writing in 1827, attributed the formation of a volcanic cone mainly to material ejected from a central opening, but also to the flow of lava into dikes, and "to that force of gaseous expansion, the 384 intensity of which, in the central parts of the cone, is evidenced by local earthquakes, which so often accompany eruptions.539 MM. Von Buch, De Beaumont, and Dufrénoy believe that the layers of lava on Somma are so uniform and solid that their original tilt didn’t exceed four or five degrees, meaning that four-fifths of their current slope is due to them being tilted and raised later. Despite the insights from M. de Beaumont on the laws governing the flow and solidification of lava, I don’t think these laws are clear enough yet to justify attributing so much of the incline of the Somma beds to the later fracturing and dislocation of the cone. Even if we accept that, it makes more sense within the usual pattern of volcanic activity to think of the movement that changed the shape of the cone as being gradual and intermittent, rather than a single massive effort or one sudden, violent upheaval.540

Vesuvian lavas.—The lavas of Somma are characterized by containing disseminated crystals of leucite (called, by the French, amphigène), a mineral said to be very rare in the modern lavas of Vesuvius, which are in general much more scoriaceous and less crystalline than those of Somma.541

Vesuvian lavas.—The lavas of Somma are known for having scattered crystals of leucite (referred to by the French as amphigène), a mineral that's considered quite rare in the current lavas of Vesuvius, which tend to be much more scoriaceous and less crystalline compared to those of Somma.541

At the fortress near Torre del Greco a section is exposed, fifteen feet in height, of a current which ran into the sea; and it evinces, especially in the lower part, a decided tendency to divide into rude columns. A still more striking example may be seen to the west of Torre del Annunziata, near Forte Scassato, where the mass is laid open to the depth of twenty feet. In both these cases, however, the rock may rather be said to be divided into numerous perpendicular fissures, than to be prismatic, although the same picturesque effect is produced. In the lava-currents of Central France (those of the Vivarais, in particular), the uppermost portion, often forty feet or more in thickness, is an amorphous mass passing downwards into lava irregularly prismatic; and under this there is a foundation of regular and vertical columns; but these lavas are often one hundred feet or more in thickness. We can scarcely expect to discover the same phenomenon in the shallow currents of Vesuvius, where the lowest part has cooled more rapidly, although it may be looked for in modern streams in Iceland, which exceed even those of ancient France in volume.

At the fortress near Torre del Greco, there's a section that stands fifteen feet high, showcasing a current that flowed into the sea; it clearly shows, especially in the lower part, a tendency to split into rough columns. An even more striking example can be found to the west of Torre del Annunziata, near Forte Scassato, where the mass is exposed to a depth of twenty feet. In both cases, however, the rock is more accurately described as being divided into numerous vertical cracks rather than being prismatic, although it creates a similar picturesque effect. In the lava flows of Central France (particularly those of the Vivarais), the uppermost layer, often forty feet thick or more, is an amorphous mass that transitions downwards into irregularly prismatic lava; beneath this, there is a base of straight vertical columns, but these lavas can be over one hundred feet thick. We can hardly expect to find the same phenomenon in the shallow flows of Vesuvius, where the bottom has cooled more quickly, although it might be observed in recent lava streams in Iceland, which are even larger in volume than those of ancient France.

Mr. Scrope mentions that, in the cliffs encircling the modern crater of Vesuvius, he saw many currents offering a columnar division, and some almost as regularly prismatic as any ranges of the older basalts; and he adds, that in some the spheroidal concretionary structure, on a large scale, was equally conspicuous.542 Brieslak543 also informs us that, in the 385 siliceous lava of 1737, which contains augite, leucite, and crystals of felspar, he found very regular prisms in a quarry near Torre del Greco; an observation confirmed by modern authorities.544

Mr. Scrope mentions that in the cliffs surrounding the modern crater of Vesuvius, he observed many flows displaying a columnar structure, and some were almost as regularly prismatic as any of the older basalt ranges; he also noted that in some areas, the large-scale spheroidal concretionary structure was equally evident.542 Brieslak543 also tells us that in the siliceous lava from 1737, which contains augite, leucite, and crystals of feldspar, he found very regular prisms in a quarry near Torre del Greco; an observation confirmed by modern experts.544

Effects of decomposition on lavas.—The decomposition of some of the felspathic lavas, either by simple weathering, or by gaseous emanations, converts them from a hard to a soft clayey state, so that they no longer retain the smallest resemblance to rocks cooled down from a state of fusion. The exhalations of sulphuretted hydrogen and muriatic acid, which are disengaged continually from the Solfatara, also produce curious changes on the trachyte of that nearly extinct volcano: the rock is bleached, and becomes porous, fissile, and honey-combed, till at length it crumbles into a white siliceous powder.545 Numerous globular concretions, composed of concentric laminæ, are also formed by the same vapors in this decomposed rock.546

Effects of decomposition on lavas.—The breakdown of some of the feldspathic lavas, either through simple weathering or by gas emissions, changes them from a hard state to a soft, clay-like condition, so that they no longer bear any resemblance to rocks that cooled from a molten state. The release of hydrogen sulfide and hydrochloric acid, which continuously come from the Solfatara, also causes interesting alterations to the trachyte of that nearly extinct volcano: the rock becomes bleached, porous, flaky, and honeycombed, until it eventually crumbles into a white siliceous powder.545 Numerous globular concretions, made up of concentric layers, are also created by the same vapors in this decomposed rock.546

Vesuvian minerals.—A great variety of minerals are found in the lavas of Vesuvius and Somma; augite, leucite, felspar, mica, olivine, and sulphur are most abundant. It is an extraordinary fact, that in an area of three square miles round Vesuvius, a greater number of simple minerals have been found than in any spot of the same dimensions on the surface of the globe. Häuy enumerated only 380 species of simple minerals as known to him; and no less than eighty-two had been found on Vesuvius and in the tuffs on the flanks of Somma before the end of the year 1828.547 Many of these are peculiar to that locality. Some mineralogists have conjectured that the greater part of these were not of Vesuvian origin, but thrown up in fragments from some older formation, through which the gaseous explosions burst. But none of the older rocks in Italy, or elsewhere, contain such an assemblage of mineral products; and the hypothesis seems to have been prompted by a disinclination to admit that, in times so recent in the earth's history, the laboratory of nature could have been so prolific in the creation of new and rare compounds. Had Vesuvius been a volcano of high antiquity, formed when nature

Vesuvian minerals.—A wide range of minerals can be found in the lavas of Vesuvius and Somma; augite, leucite, feldspar, mica, olivine, and sulfur are the most common. It's remarkable that in an area of three square miles around Vesuvius, more types of simple minerals have been discovered than in any other area of the same size on Earth. Häuy listed only 380 species of simple minerals that he knew of; yet, by the end of 1828, no less than eighty-two had been found on Vesuvius and in the tuffs on the slopes of Somma.547 Many of these are unique to that area. Some mineralogists have speculated that most of these minerals did not originate from Vesuvius, but were ejected in fragments from some older formation that the gaseous explosions penetrated. However, none of the older rocks in Italy, or elsewhere, contain such a variety of mineral products, and this theory seems to stem from a reluctance to accept that, in such recent times in Earth's history, nature's laboratory could create new and rare compounds so abundantly. If Vesuvius had been a very ancient volcano, formed when nature...

As carefree as in her youth, and did whatever she pleased. Her innocent daydreams,

it would have been readily admitted that these, or a much greater variety of substances, had been sublimed in the crevices of lava, just as several new earthy and metallic compounds are known to have been produced by fumeroles, since the eruption of 1822.

it would have been easily acknowledged that these, or a much wider range of substances, had been created in the cracks of lava, just as several new earth and metal compounds are known to have been formed by fumeroles since the eruption of 1822.

Mass enveloping Herculaneum and Pompeii.—In addition to the ejections which fall on the cone, and that much greater mass which finds its way gradually to the neighboring sea, there is a third portion, often of no inconsiderable thickness, composed of alluviums, spread over the valleys and plains at small distances from the volcano. Aqueous 386 vapors are evolved copiously from volcanic craters during eruptions, and often for a long time subsequently to the discharge of scoriæ and lava: these vapors are condensed in the cold atmosphere surrounding the high volcanic peak, and heavy rains are thus caused. The floods thus occasioned, sweep along the impalpable dust and light scoriæ, till a current of mud is produced, which is called in Campania "lava d' acqua," and is often more dreaded than an igneous stream (lava di fuoco), from the greater velocity with which it moves. So late as the 27th of October, 1822, one of these alluviums descended the cone of Vesuvius, and, after overspreading much cultivated soil, flowed suddenly into the villages of St. Sebastian and Massa, where, filling the streets and interior of some of the houses, it suffocated seven persons. It will, therefore, happen very frequently that, towards the base of a volcanic cone, alternations will be found of lava, alluvium, and showers of ashes.

Mass enveloping Herculaneum and Pompeii.—In addition to the debris that falls on the cone, and the much larger mass that gradually flows into the nearby sea, there is a third component, often quite thick, made up of sediments spread across the valleys and plains not far from the volcano. Aqueous 386 vapors are released abundantly from volcanic craters during eruptions, and often continue long after the discharge of ash and lava: these vapors condense in the cold atmosphere around the high volcanic peak, leading to heavy rain. The resulting floods sweep away fine dust and light ash, creating a muddy current known in Campania as "lava d'acqua," which is often feared more than an igneous flow (lava di fuoco) because of its greater speed. As recently as October 27, 1822, one of these sediment flows came down the cone of Vesuvius and, after covering a lot of agricultural land, suddenly rushed into the villages of St. Sebastian and Massa, filling the streets and some houses, and suffocating seven people. Therefore, it is quite common to find layers of lava, sediment, and ash showers at the base of a volcanic cone.

To which of these two latter divisions the mass enveloping Herculaneum and Pompeii should be referred, has been a question of the keenest controversy; but the discussion might have been shortened, if the combatants had reflected that, whether volcanic sand and ashes were conveyed to the towns by running water, or through the air, during an eruption, the interior of buildings, so long as the roofs remain entire, together with all underground vaults and cellars, could be filled only by an alluvium. We learn from history, that a heavy shower of sand, pumice, and lapilli, sufficiently great to render Pompeii and Herculaneum uninhabitable, fell for eight successive days and nights in the year 79, accompanied by violent rains.548 We ought, therefore, to find a very close resemblance between the strata covering these towns and those composing the minor cones of the Phlegræan Fields, accumulated rapidly, like Monte Nuovo, during a continued shower of ejected matter; with this difference however, that the strata incumbent on the cities would be horizontal, whereas those on the cones are highly inclined; and that large angular fragments of rock, which are thrown out near the vent, would be wanting at a distance where small lapilli only can be found. Accordingly, with these exceptions, no identity can be more perfect than the form, and distribution of the matter at the base of Monte Nuovo, as laid open by the encroaching sea, and the appearance of the beds superimposed on Pompeii. That city is covered with numerous alternations of different horizontal beds of tuff and lapilli, for the most part thin, and subdivided into very fine layers. I observed the following section near the amphitheatre, in November, 1828—(descending series):—

To which of the two later divisions the mass covering Herculaneum and Pompeii should be classified has sparked intense debate; however, the discussion could have been shorter if the participants had considered that whether volcanic sand and ashes were brought to the towns by flowing water or airborne during an eruption, the interiors of buildings—given that the roofs remained intact—along with all underground vaults and cellars, could only be filled by sediment. History tells us that a heavy shower of sand, pumice, and lapilli, significant enough to make Pompeii and Herculaneum uninhabitable, fell for eight straight days and nights in the year 79, accompanied by heavy rains.548 Therefore, we should find a very close similarity between the layers covering these towns and those that make up the smaller cones of the Phlegræan Fields, which accumulated quickly, like Monte Nuovo, during a continuous shower of ejected materials; with this difference, however, that the layers over the cities would be horizontal, while those on the cones are steeply inclined; and that large angular rock fragments, which are expelled near the vent, would be absent at a distance where only small lapilli can be found. Accordingly, with these exceptions, there can be no more perfect similarity than the shape and distribution of the material at the base of Monte Nuovo, revealed by the advancing sea, and the appearance of the layers piled on Pompeii. That city is covered with many variations of different horizontal layers of tuff and lapilli, mostly thin and divided into very fine layers. I observed the following section near the amphitheatre in November 1828—(descending sequence):—

  Feet Inches.
1. Black sparkling sand from the eruption of 1822, containing minute regularly formed crystals of augite and tourmaline 0
2. Vegetable mould 3 0
3. Brown incoherent tuff, full of pisolitic globules in layers, from half an inch to three inches in thickness 1 6
4. Small scoriæ and white lapilli 0 3
5. Brown earthy tuff, with numerous pisolitic globules 0 9
6. Brown earthy tuff, with lapilli divided into layers 4 0
7. Layer of whitish lapilli 0 1
8. Gray solid tuff 0 3
9. Pumice and white lapilli 0 3
   —— ——
  10
   —— ——

Many of the ashes in these beds are vitrified, and harsh to the touch. Crystals of leucite, both fresh and farinaceous, have been found intermixed.549 The depth of the bed of ashes above the houses is variable, but seldom exceeds twelve or fourteen feet, and it is said that the higher part of the amphitheatre always projected above the surface; though if this were the case, it seems inexplicable that the city should never have been discovered till the year 1750. It will be observed in the above section that two of the brown, half-consolidated tuffs are filled with small pisolitic globules. This circumstance is not alluded to in the animated controversy which the Royal Academy of Naples maintained with one of their members, Signor Lippi, as to the origin of the strata incumbent on Pompeii. The mode of aggregation of these globules has been fully explained by Mr. Scrope, who saw them formed in great numbers in 1822, by rain falling during the eruption on fine volcanic sand, and sometimes also produced like hail in the air, by the mutual attraction of the minutest particles of fine damp sand. Their occurrence, therefore, agrees remarkably well with the account of heavy rain, and showers of sand and ashes recorded in history.550

Many of the ashes in these layers are vitrified and rough to the touch. Crystals of leucite, both fresh and powdery, have been found mixed in. The depth of the ash layer above the houses varies, but it seldom exceeds twelve or fourteen feet, and it’s said that the higher part of the amphitheater always stuck up above the surface; though if that were true, it’s hard to understand why the city wasn’t discovered until 1750. It can be noted in the above section that two of the brown, semi-solid tuffs contain small pisolitic globules. This fact isn't mentioned in the heated debate that the Royal Academy of Naples had with one of their members, Signor Lippi, about the origin of the layers above Pompeii. Mr. Scrope fully explained how these globules formed, noting that he saw them created in large quantities in 1822 when rain fell during the eruption on fine volcanic sand, and sometimes they also formed like hail in the air due to the mutual attraction of tiny particles of damp sand. Their presence is therefore very consistent with the accounts of heavy rain and showers of sand and ashes recorded in history.

Lippi entitled his work, "Fù il fuoco o l' acqua che sotterò Pompei ed Ercolano?"551 and he contended that neither were the two cities destroyed in the year 79, nor by a volcanic eruption, but purely by the agency of water charged with transported matter. His letters, wherein he endeavored to dispense, as far as possible, with igneous agency, even at the foot of the volcano, were dedicated, with great propriety, to Werner, and afford an amusing illustration of the polemic style in which geological writers of that day indulged themselves. His arguments were partly of an historical nature, derived from the silence of contemporary historians, respecting the fate of the cities, which, as we have already stated, is most remarkable, and partly drawn from physical proofs. He pointed out with great clearness the resemblance of the tufaceous matter in the vaults and cellars at Herculaneum and Pompeii to aqueous alluviums, and its distinctness from ejections which had fallen through the air. Nothing, he observes, but moist pasty matter could have received the impression of a woman's breast, which was found in a vault at Pompeii, 388 or have given the cast of a statue discovered in the theatre at Herculaneum. It was objected to him, that the heat of the tuff in Herculaneum and Pompeii was proved by the carbonization of the timber, corn, papyrus-rolls, and other vegetable substances there discovered; but Lippi replied with truth, that the papyri would have been burnt up if they had come in contact with fire, and that their being only carbonized was a clear demonstration of their having been enveloped, like fossil wood, in a sediment deposited from water. The Academicians, in their report on his pamphlet, assert, that when the amphitheatre was first cleared out, the matter was arranged on the steps in a succession of concave layers, accommodating themselves to the interior form of the building, just as snow would lie if it had fallen there. This observation is highly interesting, and points to the difference between the stratification of ashes in an open building and of mud derived from the same in the interior of edifices and cellars. Nor ought we to call the allegation in question, because it could not be substantiated at the time of the controversy after the matter had been all removed; although Lippi took advantage of this removal, and met the argument of his antagonists by requiring them to prove the fact. There is decisive evidence that no stream of lava has ever reached Pompeii since it was first built, although the foundations of the town stand upon the old leucitic lava of Somma; several streams of which, with tuff interposed, had been cut through in excavations.

Lippi named his work, "Was it fire or water that buried Pompeii and Herculaneum?"551 and argued that neither city was destroyed in 79 AD, nor by a volcanic eruption, but solely by water carrying debris. His letters, where he tried to minimize the role of fire, even at the base of the volcano, were appropriately dedicated to Werner and provide an entertaining example of the argumentative style used by geological writers of that time. His points were partly historical, based on the lack of mentions by contemporary historians regarding the cities' fate, which we noted is quite striking, and partly based on physical evidence. He clearly indicated the similarity of the tufa found in the vaults and cellars of Herculaneum and Pompeii to deposits left by water, distinguishing it from material that had fallen from the air. He noted that only soft, moist matter could have left an impression of a woman's breast found in a vault at Pompeii, or produced the cast of a statue discovered in the theater at Herculaneum. Critics argued that the heat of the tuff in Herculaneum and Pompeii was demonstrated by the carbonization of wooden beams, grains, papyrus rolls, and other plant materials found there; but Lippi responded accurately that the papyri would have been completely incinerated if they had touched fire, and their carbonization was clear evidence that they were buried, like fossilized wood, in sediment laid down by water. The Academicians, in their report on his pamphlet, claimed that when the amphitheater was first excavated, the material was layered concavely on the steps, conforming to the building's interior shape, just like snow would settle if it fell there. This observation is very interesting and highlights the difference between ash layers in an open structure and mud layers found inside buildings and cellars. We shouldn't doubt this claim just because it couldn't be verified during the controversy after everything was cleared away; Lippi took advantage of the situation and challenged his opponents to prove their point. There's clear evidence that no lava flow has ever reached Pompeii since it was established, even though the town's foundations rest on the ancient leucitic lava from Somma; several lava flows, with tuff in between, were cut through during excavations.

Infusorial beds covering Pompeii.—A most singular and unexpected discovery has been recently made (1844-5) by Professor Ehrenberg, respecting the remote origin of many of the layers of ashes and pumice enveloping Pompeii. They are, he says, in great part, of organic and freshwater origin, consisting of the siliceous cases of microscopic infusoria. What is still more surprising, this fact proves to be by no means an isolated or solitary example of an intimate relation between organic life and the results of volcanic activity. On the Rhine, several beds of tuff and pumiceous conglomerate, resembling the mass incumbent upon Pompeii and closely connected with extinct volcanoes, are now ascertained to be made up to a great extent of the siliceous cases of infusoria (or Diatomaceæ), invisible to the naked eye, and often half fused.552 No less than 94 distinct species have already been detected in one mass of this kind, more than 150 feet thick, at Hochsimmer, on the left bank of the Rhine, near the Laacher-see. Some of these Rhenish infusorial accumulations appear to have fallen in showers, others to have been poured out of lake-craters in the form of mud, as in the Brohl valley.

Infusorial beds covering Pompeii.—A very unique and unexpected discovery has recently been made (1844-5) by Professor Ehrenberg regarding the ancient origins of many layers of ash and pumice surrounding Pompeii. He states that they are largely of organic and freshwater origin, consisting of the siliceous cases of microscopic infusoria. Even more surprising, this fact is not an isolated case; it shows a deep connection between organic life and volcanic activity. Along the Rhine, several layers of tuff and pumice conglomerate, similar to what covers Pompeii and linked to extinct volcanoes, have been found to be mostly made up of the siliceous cases of infusoria (or Diatomaceæ), which are not visible to the naked eye and often partially fused.552 As many as 94 different species have already been identified in one such layer, over 150 feet thick, at Hochsimmer, on the left bank of the Rhine, near Laacher See. Some of these infusorial deposits from the Rhine seem to have fallen like rain, while others appear to have been expelled from lake craters in the form of mud, as seen in the Brohl valley.

In Mexico, Peru, the Isle of France, and several other volcanic regions, analogous phenomena have been observed, and everywhere the species of infusoria belong to freshwater and terrestrial genera, except in the case of the Patagonian pumiceous tuffs, specimens of which, brought 389 home by Mr. Darwin, are found to contain the remains of marine animalcules. In various kinds of pumice ejected by volcanoes, the microscope has revealed to Professor Ehrenberg the siliceous cases of infusoria often half obliterated by the action of heat, and the fine dust thrown out into the air during eruptions, is sometimes referable to these most minute organic substances, brought up from considerable depths, and sometimes mingled with small particles of vegetable matter.

In places like Mexico, Peru, the Isle of France, and other volcanic areas, similar events have been noticed, and the types of infusoria found are typically from freshwater and land species, except for the Patagonian pumice tuffs. Samples of these, collected by Mr. Darwin, contain remains of marine microorganisms. In different types of pumice released by volcanoes, Professor Ehrenberg has identified siliceous shells of infusoria that are often partially destroyed by heat. The fine dust that gets released into the air during eruptions can sometimes be traced back to these tiny organic materials, which have been drawn up from deep underground and occasionally mixed with small bits of plant matter.

In what manner did the solid coverings of these most minute plants and animalcules, which can only originate and increase at the surface of the earth, sink down and penetrate into subterranean cavities, so as to be ejected from the volcanic orifices? We have of late years become familiar with the fact, in the process of boring Artesian wells, that the seeds of plants, the remains of insects, and even small fish, with other organic bodies, are carried in an uninjured state by the underground circulation of waters, to the depth of many hundred feet. With still greater facility in a volcanic region we may conjecture, that water and mud full of invisible infusoria may be sucked down, from time to time, into subterranean rents and hollows in cavernous lava which has been permeated by gases, or in rocks dislocated by earthquakes. It often happens that a lake which has endured for centuries in a volcanic crater, disappears suddenly on the approach of a new eruption. Violent shocks agitate the surrounding region, and ponds, rivers, and wells are dried up. Large cavities far below may thus become filled with fen-mud chiefly composed of the more indestructible and siliceous portions of infusoria, destined perhaps to be one day ejected in a fragmentary or half-fused state, yet without the obliteration of all traces of organic structure.553

How did the solid coverings of these tiny plants and microorganisms, which can only grow and thrive on the earth's surface, end up sinking down and entering into underground cavities, allowing them to be ejected from volcanic openings? Recently, we've learned through the boring of Artesian wells that seeds, insect remains, and even small fish, along with other organic materials, can be carried in an intact state by underground water circulation down to depths of several hundred feet. In volcanic regions, we can imagine that water and mud, teeming with tiny invisible organisms, can be drawn down occasionally into underground fissures and cavities in gas-permeated lava or in rocks that have been disturbed by earthquakes. Often, a lake that has existed for centuries in a volcanic crater suddenly vanishes ahead of a new eruption. Intense shocks shake the surrounding area, drying up ponds, rivers, and wells. Large cavities deep below may then fill with mud primarily made up of the more durable and siliceous parts of these microorganisms, which might, one day, be expelled in a broken or semi-melted form, yet still retaining some evidence of their original biological structure.553

Herculaneum.—It was remarked that no lava has flowed over the site of Pompeii, since that city was built, but with Herculaneum the case is different. Although the substance which fills the interior of the houses and the vaults must have been introduced in a state of mud, like that found in similar situations in Pompeii; yet the superincumbent mass differs wholly in composition and thickness. Herculaneum was situated several miles nearer to the volcano, and has, therefore, been always more exposed to be covered, not only by showers of ashes, but by alluviums and streams of lava. Accordingly, masses of both have 390 accumulated on each other above the city, to a depth of nowhere less than 70, and in many places of 112 feet.554

Herculaneum.—It was noted that no lava has flowed over the site of Pompeii since that city was established, but Herculaneum is a different story. Even though the material filling the insides of the houses and vaults must have been deposited in a muddy state, similar to what’s found in Pompeii, the overlying mass is completely different in composition and thickness. Herculaneum was located several miles closer to the volcano, making it more vulnerable to being covered not just by ash falls but also by sediment and streams of lava. As a result, layers of both have built up above the city to a depth of at least 70 feet and in many places up to 112 feet.390554

The tuff which envelops the buildings consists of comminuted volcanic ashes, mixed with pumice. A mask imbedded in this matrix has left a cast, the sharpness of which was compared by Hamilton to those in plaster of Paris; nor was the mask in the least degree scorched, as if it had been imbedded in heated matter. This tuff is porous; and, when first excavated, is soft and easily worked, but acquires a considerable degree of induration on exposure to the air. Above this lowest stratum is placed, according to Hamilton, "the matter of six eruptions," each separated from the other by veins of good soil. In these soils Lippi states that he collected a considerable number of land shells—an observation which is no doubt correct; for many snails burrow in soft soils, and some Italian species descend, when they hybernate, to the depth of five feet and more from the surface. Della Torre also informs us that there is in one part of this superimposed mass a bed of true siliceous lava (lava di pietra dura); and, as no such current is believed to have flowed till near one thousand years after the destruction of Herculaneum, we must conclude, that the origin of a large part of the covering of Herculaneum was long subsequent to the first inhumation of the place. That city, as well as Pompeii, was a seaport. Herculaneum is still very near the shore, but a tract of land, a mile in length, intervenes between the borders of the Bay of Naples and Pompeii. In both cases the gain of land is due to the filling up of the bed of the sea with volcanic matter, and not to elevation by earthquakes, for there has been no change in the relative level of land and sea. Pompeii stood on a slight eminence composed of the lavas of the ancient Vesuvius, and flights of steps led down to the water's edge. The lowermost of these steps are said to be still on an exact level with the sea.

The tuff surrounding the buildings is made up of crushed volcanic ash mixed with pumice. A mask embedded in this material has left a sharp outline, which Hamilton compared to casts made from plaster of Paris; the mask wasn't scorched at all, as if it had been buried in something hot. This tuff is porous, and when it’s first dug up, it's soft and easy to shape, but it hardens significantly when exposed to air. Above this bottom layer, according to Hamilton, lies "the matter of six eruptions," each separated by layers of good soil. In these soils, Lippi states that he collected several land shells — this observation is undoubtedly accurate since many snails burrow into soft soils, and some Italian species dig down to five feet or more below the surface when they hibernate. Della Torre also tells us that in one section of this upper layer, there’s a bed of true siliceous lava (lava di pietra dura); since no such eruption is thought to have occurred until almost a thousand years after the destruction of Herculaneum, we can conclude that much of the material covering Herculaneum came long after the city was first buried. That city, like Pompeii, was a seaport. Herculaneum is still very close to the shore, but there's a mile-long stretch of land separating the Bay of Naples from Pompeii. In both instances, the expansion of land is due to the filling of the sea floor with volcanic material, not because of uplift from earthquakes, as there has been no change in the relative levels of land and sea. Pompeii was built on a slight rise made from the lavas of the ancient Vesuvius, and there were steps leading down to the water's edge. The lowest of these steps are said to still be at the same level as the sea.

Condition and contents of the buried cities.—After these observations on the nature of the strata enveloping and surrounding the cities, we may proceed to consider their internal condition and contents, so far at least as they offer facts of geological interest. Notwithstanding the much greater depth at which Herculaneum was buried, it was discovered before Pompeii, by the accidental circumstance of a well being sunk, in 1713, which came right down upon the theatre, where the statues of Hercules and Cleopatra were soon found. Whether this city or Pompeii, both of them founded by Greek colonies, was the more considerable, is not yet determined; but both are mentioned by ancient authors as among the seven most flourishing cities in Campania. The walls of Pompeii were three miles in circumference; but we have, as yet, no certain knowledge of the dimensions of Herculaneum. In the latter place the theatre alone is open for inspection; the Forum, Temple of Jupiter, and other buildings, having been filled up with rubbish as the workmen proceeded, owing to the difficulty of removing it from so 391 great a depth below ground. Even the theatre is only seen by torchlight, and the most interesting information, perhaps, which the geologist obtains there, is the continual formation of stalactite in the galleries cut through the tuff; for there is a constant percolation of water charged with carbonate of lime mixed with a small portion of magnesia. Such mineral waters must, in the course of time, create great changes in many rocks; especially in lavas, the pores of which they may fill with calcareous spar, so as to convert them into amygdaloids. Some geologists, therefore, are unreasonable when they expect that volcanic rocks of remote eras should accord precisely with those of modern date; since it is obvious that many of those produced in our own time will not long retain the same aspect and internal composition.

Condition and contents of the buried cities.—After looking at the nature of the layers surrounding the cities, we can move on to their internal condition and contents, at least to the extent that they provide interesting geological facts. Even though Herculaneum was buried at a greater depth, it was discovered before Pompeii, thanks to an accidental well being dug in 1713 that hit the theater, where the statues of Hercules and Cleopatra were soon found. It’s still uncertain which city, Herculaneum or Pompeii, both founded by Greek colonies, was more significant; however, both are noted by ancient authors as among the seven most prosperous cities in Campania. The walls of Pompeii measured three miles around, but we don’t yet know the exact size of Herculaneum. In Herculaneum, only the theater is open to visitors; the Forum, the Temple of Jupiter, and other buildings have been buried under debris as workers tried to clear them, due to the challenge of removing materials from such a deep location. Even the theater can only be seen by torchlight, and perhaps the most fascinating information the geologist can gather there is the ongoing formation of stalactites in the galleries cut through the tuff; there is a constant flow of water rich in carbonate of lime mixed with a small amount of magnesia. Over time, such mineral waters can cause significant changes in many rocks, especially in lavas, filling their pores with calcareous spar and turning them into amygdaloids. Some geologists, therefore, are unreasonable when they expect volcanic rocks from ancient times to match exactly with modern ones; it’s clear that many rocks formed in our time won’t keep the same appearance and internal structure for long.

Both at Herculaneum and Pompeii, temples have been found with inscriptions commemorating the rebuilding of the edifices after they had been thrown down by an earthquake.555 This earthquake happened in the reign of Nero, sixteen years before the cities were overwhelmed. In Pompeii, one-fourth of which is now laid open to the day, both the public and private buildings bear testimony to the catastrophe. The walls are rent, and in many places traversed by fissures still open. Columns are lying on the ground only half hewn from huge blocks of travertin, and the temple for which they were designed is seen half repaired. In some few places the pavement had sunk in, but in general it was undisturbed, consisting of large irregular flags of lava joined neatly together, in which the carriage wheels have often worn ruts an inch and a half deep. In the wider streets, the ruts are numerous and irregular; in the narrower, there are only two, one on each side, which are very conspicuous. It is impossible not to look with some interest even on these ruts, which were worn by chariot wheels more than seventeen centuries ago; and, independently of their antiquity, it is remarkable to see such deep incisions so continuous in a stone of great hardness.

Both in Herculaneum and Pompeii, temples have been discovered with inscriptions that celebrate the rebuilding of the structures after they were destroyed by an earthquake.555 This earthquake occurred during Nero's reign, sixteen years before the cities were buried. In Pompeii, where a quarter of the site is now exposed, both public and private buildings bear witness to the disaster. The walls are cracked, with many areas still showing open fissures. Columns lie on the ground, only partially carved from massive blocks of travertine, and the temple they were meant for appears only partly restored. In a few areas, the pavement has sunk, but generally, it remains intact, made of large, uneven lava flags fitted together neatly, in which carriage wheels have worn ruts as deep as an inch and a half. In the wider streets, the ruts are numerous and irregular; in the narrower ones, there are only two, one on each side, which stand out clearly. It’s hard not to find some fascination in these ruts, created by chariot wheels over seventeen centuries ago; and aside from their age, it’s impressive to see such deep grooves so consistently marked in stone that is very hard.

Small number of skeletons.—A very small number of skeletons have been discovered in either city; and it is clear that most of the inhabitants not only found time to escape, but also to carry with them the principal part of their valuable effects. In the barracks at Pompeii were the skeletons of two soldiers chained to the stocks, and in the vaults of a country-house in the suburbs were the skeletons of seventeen persons, who appear to have fled there to escape from the shower of ashes. They were found inclosed in an indurated tuff, and in this matrix was preserved a perfect cast of a woman, perhaps the mistress of the house, with an infant in her arms. Although her form was imprinted on the rock, nothing but the bones remained. To these a chain of gold was suspended, and on the fingers of the skeletons were rings with jewels. Against the sides of the same vault was ranged a long line of earthen amphoræ.

Small number of skeletons.—A very small number of skeletons have been found in either city, and it's clear that most of the people not only had time to flee but also to take most of their valuable belongings with them. In the barracks at Pompeii, there were the skeletons of two soldiers chained to the stocks, and in the vaults of a country house in the suburbs, the skeletons of seventeen individuals were discovered, who seem to have escaped there to avoid the falling ash. They were found encased in hardened tuff, and within this material, a perfect cast of a woman—likely the mistress of the house—holding an infant in her arms was preserved. Although her shape was imprinted on the rock, only the bones remained. A gold chain was found suspended from the bones, and rings adorned the fingers of the skeletons, set with jewels. Along the sides of the same vault were lined up a long row of earthen amphorae.

392 The writings scribbled by the soldiers on the walls of their barracks, and the names of the owners of each house written over the doors, are still perfectly legible. The colors of fresco paintings on the stuccoed walls in the interior of buildings are almost as vivid as if they were just finished. There are public fountains decorated with shells laid out in patterns in the same fashion as those now seen in the town of Naples; and in the room of a painter, who was perhaps a naturalist, a large collection of shells was found, comprising a great variety of Mediterranean species, in as good a state of preservation as if they had remained for the same number of years in a museum. A comparison of these remains, with those found so generally in a fossil state would not assist us in obtaining the least insight into the time required to produce a certain degree of decomposition or mineralization; for, although under favorable circumstances much greater alteration might doubtless have been brought about in a shorter period, yet the example before us shows that an inhumation of seventeen centuries may sometimes effect nothing towards the reduction of shells to the state in which fossils are usually found.

392 The writings scrawled by soldiers on the walls of their barracks, and the names of homeowners inscribed above their doors, are still completely readable. The colors of the frescoes on the plastered walls inside the buildings are nearly as bright as if they were just completed. There are public fountains adorned with shells arranged in patterns similar to those currently seen in the town of Naples; and in a painter's studio, who might have been a naturalist, a large collection of shells was discovered, showcasing a wide variety of Mediterranean species, preserved so well that they could have spent the same amount of time in a museum. Comparing these remains with those typically found in fossil form wouldn't help us understand the time needed for a certain level of decomposition or mineralization; because, even though, under the right conditions, much greater changes could likely occur in a shorter period, the example in front of us shows that a burial of seventeen centuries may sometimes not lead to any reduction of shells to the state in which fossils are usually found.

The wooden beams in the houses at Herculaneum are black on the exterior, but, when cleft open, they appear to be almost in the state of ordinary wood, and the progress made by the whole mass towards the state of lignite is scarcely appreciable. Some animal and vegetable substances of more perishable kinds have of course suffered much change and decay, yet the state of preservation of these is truly remarkable. Fishing-nets are very abundant in both cities, often quite entire; and their number at Pompeii is the more interesting from the sea being now, as we stated, a mile distant. Linen has been found at Herculaneum, with the texture well defined; and in a fruiterer's shop in that city were discovered vessels full of almonds, chestnuts, walnuts, and fruit of the "carubiere," all distinctly recognizable from their shape. A loaf, also, still retaining its form, was found in a baker's shop, with his name stamped upon it. On the counter of an apothecary was a box of pills converted into a fine earthy substance; and by the side of it a small cylindrical roll evidently prepared to be cut into pills. By the side of these was a jar containing medicinal herbs. In 1827, moist olives were found in a square glass-case, and "caviare," or roe of a fish, in a state of wonderful preservation. An examination of these curious condiments has been published by Covelli of Naples, and they are preserved hermetically sealed in the museum there.556

The wooden beams in the houses at Herculaneum are black on the outside, but when you cut them open, they look almost like regular wood, and the shift to lignite is barely noticeable. Some animal and plant materials that are more perishable have definitely changed and decayed a lot, but their level of preservation is really impressive. Fishing nets are very common in both cities, often still intact; the number found in Pompeii is especially interesting since the sea is now, as mentioned, a mile away. Linen has been discovered in Herculaneum, with the texture well-defined; and in a fruit seller's shop in that city, jars filled with almonds, chestnuts, walnuts, and fruit of the "carubiere" were found, all easily identifiable by their shape. A loaf of bread, still keeping its form, was found in a baker's shop, with his name stamped on it. On the counter of a pharmacy, there was a box of pills that had turned into a fine earthy substance, and next to it, a small cylindrical roll clearly meant to be cut into pills. Alongside these was a jar containing medicinal herbs. In 1827, moist olives were discovered in a square glass case, and caviar, or fish roe, in an incredibly well-preserved state. Covelli of Naples published an examination of these interesting condiments, and they are kept hermetically sealed in the museum there.556

Papyri.—There is a marked difference in the condition and appearance of the animal and vegetable substances found at Pompeii and Herculaneum; those of Pompeii being penetrated by a gray pulverulent tuff, those in Herculaneum seeming to have been first enveloped by a paste which consolidated round them, and then allowed them to become slowly carbonized. Some of the rolls of papyrus at Pompeii 393 still retain their form; but the writing, and indeed almost all the vegetable matter, appear to have vanished, and to have been replaced by volcanic tuff somewhat pulverulent. At Herculaneum the earthy matter has scarcely ever penetrated; and the vegetable substance of the papyrus has become a thin friable black matter, almost resembling in appearance the tinder which remains when stiff paper has been burnt, in which the letters may still be sometimes traced. The small bundles of papyri, composed of five or six rolls tied up together, had sometimes lain horizontally, and were pressed in that direction, but sometimes they had been placed in a vertical position. Small tickets were attached to each bundle, on which the title of the work was inscribed. In one case only have the sheets been found with writing on both sides of the pages. So numerous are the obliterations and corrections, that many must have been original manuscripts. The variety of handwritings is quite extraordinary: nearly all are written in Greek, but there are a few in Latin. They were almost all found in a suburban villa in the library of one private individual; and the titles of four hundred of those least injured, which have been read, are found to be unimportant works, but all entirely new, chiefly relating to music, rhetoric, and cookery. There are two volumes of Epicurus "On Nature," and the others are mostly by writers of the same school, only one fragment having been discovered, by an opponent of the Epicurean system, Chrysippus.557

Papyri.—There’s a noticeable difference in the condition and appearance of the animal and plant materials found in Pompeii and Herculaneum; those from Pompeii are covered in a gray powdery tuff, while those in Herculaneum seem to have been first surrounded by a paste that hardened around them, allowing them to slowly become carbonized. Some of the papyrus rolls in Pompeii still keep their shape; however, the writing, and nearly all the plant material, appear to have disappeared, replaced by volcanic tuff that is somewhat powdery. In Herculaneum, the earthy material has hardly penetrated; the plant substance of the papyrus has turned into a thin, crumbly black matter, looking almost like the charred remains of burnt paper, with letters that can sometimes still be traced. The small bundles of papyri, made up of five or six rolls tied together, were sometimes positioned horizontally and pressed that way, but at other times they were placed vertically. Small tags were attached to each bundle, showing the title of the work. Only in one instance were sheets found with writing on both sides of the pages. The number of corrections and erasures is so high that many must have been original manuscripts. The variety of handwriting is quite remarkable: nearly all are in Greek, with just a few in Latin. They were mostly discovered in a suburban villa from the library of one individual; the titles of four hundred of the least damaged, which have been read, are found to be unremarkable works, but all completely new, mainly about music, rhetoric, and cooking. There are two volumes of Epicurus' "On Nature," and the rest are mostly by writers from the same school, with only one fragment found from a critic of the Epicurean system, Chrysippus.557

Probability of future discoveries of MSS.—In the opinion of some antiquaries, not one-hundredth part of the city has yet been explored: and the quarters hitherto cleared out at a great expense, are those where there was the least probability of discovering manuscripts. As Italy could already boast her splendid Roman amphitheatres and Greek temples, it was a matter of secondary interest to add to their number those in the dark and dripping galleries of Herculaneum; and having so many of the masterpieces of ancient art, we could have dispensed with the inferior busts and statues which could alone have been expected to reward our researches in the ruins of a provincial town. But from the moment that it was ascertained that rolls of papyrus preserved in this city could still be deciphered, every exertion ought to have been steadily and exclusively directed towards the discovery of other libraries. Private dwellings should have been searched, before so much labor and expense were consumed in examining public edifices. A small portion of that zeal and enlightened spirit which prompted the late French and Tuscan expedition to Egypt might long ere this, in a country nearer home, have snatched from oblivion some of the lost works of the Augustan age, or of eminent Greek historians and philosophers. A single roll of papyrus might have disclosed more 394 matter of intense interest than all that was ever written in hieroglyphics.

Probability of future discoveries of MSS.—Some historians believe that less than one percent of the city has been explored so far, and the areas that have been excavated at great cost are the ones where there is the least chance of finding manuscripts. While Italy can already pride itself on its magnificent Roman amphitheaters and Greek temples, adding more to the dark and damp tunnels of Herculaneum is of secondary importance; and with so many masterpieces of ancient art at our disposal, we could have done without the lesser-quality busts and statues that were the only likely rewards from exploring the ruins of a provincial town. However, once it was confirmed that rolls of papyrus preserved in this city could still be read, all efforts should have been focused solely on finding other libraries. Private homes should have been searched before so much effort and money went into examining public buildings. A fraction of the enthusiasm and insight that motivated the recent French and Tuscan expedition to Egypt could have long ago uncovered some of the lost works from the Augustan age, or writings from notable Greek historians and philosophers, right in a neighboring country. One single roll of papyrus could have revealed more captivating content than everything written in hieroglyphics combined.

Stabiæ.—Besides the cities already mentioned, Stabiæ, a small town about six miles from Vesuvius, and near the site of the modern Castel-a-Mare (see map of volcanic district of Naples), was overwhelmed during the eruption of 79. Pliny mentions that, when his uncle was there, he was obliged to make his escape, so great was the quantity of falling stones and ashes. In the ruins of this place, a few skeletons have been found buried in volcanic ejections, together with some antiquities of no great value, and rolls of papyrus, which, like those of Pompeii, were illegible.

Stabiæ.—In addition to the cities already mentioned, Stabiæ, a small town about six miles from Vesuvius and near the site of the modern Castel-a-Mare (see map of the volcanic district of Naples), was buried during the eruption of 79. Pliny notes that when his uncle was there, he had to escape due to the massive amount of falling rocks and ash. In the ruins of this site, a few skeletons have been found buried under volcanic material, along with some antiquities of little value and rolls of papyrus, which, like those in Pompeii, were unreadable.

Torre del Greco overflowed by lava.—Of the towns hitherto mentioned, Herculaneum alone has been overflowed by a stream of melted matter; but this did not, as we have seen, enter or injure the buildings, which were previously enveloped or covered over with tuff. But burning torrents have often taken their course through the streets of Torre del Greco, and consumed or inclosed a large portion of the town in solid rock. It seems probable that the destruction of three thousand of its inhabitants in 1631, which some accounts attribute to boiling water, was principally due to one of those alluvial floods which we before mentioned: but, in 1737, the lava itself flowed through the eastern side of the town, and afterwards reached the sea; and, in 1794, another current, rolling over the western side, filled the streets and houses, and killed more than four hundred persons. The main street is now quarried through this lava, which supplied building stones for new houses erected where others had been annihilated. The church was half buried in a rocky mass, but the upper portion served as the foundation of a new edifice.

Torre del Greco was covered by lava.—Among the towns mentioned so far, only Herculaneum was covered by a flow of molten material; however, as we have seen, it did not penetrate or damage the buildings, which were already wrapped or shielded by tuff. But scorching torrents have frequently moved through the streets of Torre del Greco, burying or encasing a large part of the town in solid rock. It seems likely that the death of three thousand residents in 1631, which some reports attribute to boiling water, was mainly caused by one of those alluvial floods we mentioned earlier. However, in 1737, lava flowed through the eastern side of the town and eventually reached the sea; in 1794, another flow rolled over the western side, filling the streets and homes, resulting in the deaths of more than four hundred people. The main street is now carved through this lava, which provided stones for new houses built where others had been destroyed. The church was partially buried under a rock mass, but the upper part served as the foundation for a new building.

The number of the population at present is estimated at fifteen thousand; and a satisfactory answer may readily be returned to those who inquire how the inhabitants can be so "inattentive to the voice of time and the warnings of nature,"558 as to rebuild their dwellings on a spot so often devastated. No neighboring site unoccupied by a town, or which would not be equally insecure, combines the same advantages of proximity to the capital, to the sea, and to the rich lands on the flanks of Vesuvius. If the present population were exiled, they would immediately be replaced by another, for the same reason that the Maremma of Tuscany and the Campagna di Roma will never be depopulated, although the malaria fever commits more havoc in a few years than the Vesuvian lavas in as many centuries. The district around Naples supplies one amongst innumerable examples, that those regions where the surface is most frequently renewed, and where the renovation is accompanied, at different intervals of time, by partial destruction of animal and vegetable life, may nevertheless be amongst the most habitable and delightful on our globe.

The current population is estimated to be around fifteen thousand, and there's a straightforward answer for those who wonder why the residents can be so "unconcerned about the passing of time and the warnings of nature,"558 that they rebuild their homes in a place that's faced so much devastation. There isn’t another site nearby that isn’t already occupied by a town or that wouldn’t be just as vulnerable, while still offering the same benefits of being close to the capital, the sea, and the fertile lands on the slopes of Vesuvius. If the current inhabitants were to leave, they would be quickly replaced for the same reason that the Maremma of Tuscany and the Campagna di Roma will never lose their population, even though malaria causes more destruction in just a few years than the Vesuvius lava flows do in centuries. The area around Naples is just one of countless examples showing that regions where the landscape is often renewed, and where this renewal involves the periodic loss of animal and plant life, can still be among the most pleasant and livable places on earth.

395 I have already made a similar remark when speaking of tracts where aqueous causes are now most active; and the observation applies as well to parts of the surface which are the abode of aquatic animals, as to those which support terrestrial species. The sloping sides of Vesuvius give nourishment to a vigorous and healthy population of about eighty thousand souls; and the surrounding hills and plains, together with several of the adjoining isles, owe the fertility of their soil to matter ejected by prior eruptions. Had the fundamental limestone of the Apennines remained uncovered throughout the whole area, the country could not have sustained a twentieth part of its present inhabitants. This will be apparent to every geologist who has marked the change in the agricultural character of the soil the moment he has passed the utmost boundary of the volcanic ejections, as when, for example, at the distance of about seven miles from Vesuvius, he leaves the plain and ascends the declivity of the Sorrentine Hills.

395 I've already mentioned something similar when talking about areas where water-related processes are currently most active; this observation is equally true for regions inhabited by aquatic creatures as it is for those that host land species. The sloping sides of Vesuvius support a robust and healthy population of around eighty thousand people, and the nearby hills and plains, along with several neighboring islands, owe their fertile soil to materials released by previous eruptions. If the underlying limestone of the Apennines had stayed exposed over the entire area, the region would not be able to support even a fraction of its current population. This will be clear to any geologist who notices the shift in the agricultural quality of the soil as soon as they cross the outer edge of the volcanic deposits, such as when they are about seven miles from Vesuvius, leaving the plain and climbing the slopes of the Sorrentine Hills.

Yet, favored as this region has been by Nature from time immemorial, the signs of the changes imprinted on it during the period that it has served as the habitation of man may appear in after-ages to indicate a series of unparalleled disasters. Let us suppose that at some future time the Mediterranean should form a gulf of the great ocean, and that the waves and tidal current should encroach on the shores of Campania, as it now advances upon the eastern coast of England; the geologist will then behold the towns already buried, and many more which will evidently be entombed hereafter, laid open in the steep cliffs, where he will discover buildings superimposed above each other, with thick intervening strata of tuff or lava—some unscathed by fire, like those of Herculaneum and Pompeii; others half melted down, as in Torre del Greco; and many shattered and thrown about in strange confusion, as in Tripergola, beneath Monte Nuovo. Among the ruins will be seen skeletons of men, and impressions of the human form stamped in solid rocks of tuff. Nor will the signs of earthquakes be wanting. The pavement of part of the Domitian Way, and the temple of the Nymphs, submerged at high tide, will be uncovered at low water, the columns remaining erect and uninjured. Other temples which had once sunk down, like that of Serapis, will be found to have been upraised again by subsequent movements. If they who study these phenomena, and speculate on their causes, assume that there were periods when the laws of Nature or the whole course of natural events differed greatly from those observed in their own time, they will scarcely hesitate to refer the wonderful monuments in question to those primeval ages. When they consider the numerous proofs of reiterated catastrophes to which the region was subject, they may, perhaps, commiserate the unhappy fate of beings condemned to inhabit a planet during its nascent and chaotic state, and feel grateful that their favored race has escaped such scenes of anarchy and misrule.

Yet, as favored as this region has been by Nature for ages, the signs of the changes that have occurred during the time it has been inhabited by humans may later be viewed as evidence of a series of unmatched disasters. Imagine that, at some point in the future, the Mediterranean turns into a gulf of the great ocean, and that waves and tidal currents invade the shores of Campania, just like they currently do on the eastern coast of England; the geologist will then see towns already buried, along with many more that will clearly be entombed later, revealed in the steep cliffs, where he will discover buildings stacked on top of each other, separated by thick layers of tuff or lava—some untouched by fire, like those of Herculaneum and Pompeii; others partially melted down, as seen in Torre del Greco; and many broken and scattered in strange chaos, as in Tripergola, beneath Monte Nuovo. Among the ruins, there will be skeletons of people and imprints of human forms stamped in solid tuff rocks. There will also be evidence of earthquakes. The pavement of part of the Domitian Way, along with the temple of the Nymphs, submerged at high tide, will be exposed during low water, with the columns still standing and unharmed. Other temples that had sunk, like the one of Serapis, will be found to have been lifted again by later movements. If those who study these phenomena and speculate about their causes believe that there were times when the laws of Nature or the overall course of natural events were significantly different from what we see today, they will likely attribute these remarkable monuments to those ancient ages. When they contemplate the numerous signs of repeated disasters that the region has faced, they may, perhaps, pity the unfortunate fate of beings forced to live on a planet during its early and chaotic state, and feel thankful that their fortunate generation has escaped such scenes of disorder and misrule.

Yet what was the real condition of Campania during those years of dire convulsion? "A climate where heaven's breath smells sweet and 396 wooingly—a vigorous and luxuriant nature unparalleled in its productions—a coast which was once the fairy-land of poets, and the favorite retreat of great men. Even the tyrants of the creation loved this alluring region, spared it, adorned it, lived in it, died in it."559 The inhabitants, indeed, have enjoyed no immunity from the calamities which are the lot of mankind; but the principal evils which they have suffered must be attributed to moral, not to physical, causes—to disastrous events over which man might have exercised a control, rather than to the inevitable catastrophes which result from subterranean agency. When Spartacus encamped his army of ten thousand gladiators in the old extinct crater of Vesuvius, the volcano was more justly a subject of terror to Campania, than it has ever been since the rekindling of its fires.

Yet what was the actual situation in Campania during those years of major upheaval? "A climate where the air is sweet and inviting—an energetic and lush nature unmatched in its bounty—a coast that was once the fairy-tale land of poets and the preferred retreat of great figures. Even the tyrants of the age loved this captivating region, spared it, beautified it, lived in it, and died in it."396 The residents, indeed, have not escaped the misfortunes shared by humankind; but the main troubles they faced should be attributed to moral rather than physical causes—catastrophic events that humans could have influenced, rather than the unavoidable disasters that arise from underground forces. When Spartacus set up his camp of ten thousand gladiators in the old, dormant crater of Vesuvius, the volcano was a far more valid source of fear for Campania than it has ever been since it reignited.


CHAPTER XXV.

ETNA.

External physiognomy of Etna—Lateral cones—Their successive obliteration—Early eruptions—Monti Rossi in 1669—Towns overflowed by lava—Part of Catania overflowed—Mode of advance of a current of lava—Subterranean caverns—Marine strata at base of Etna—Val del Bove not an ancient crater—Its scenery—Form, composition, and origin of the dikes—Linear direction of cones formed in 1811 and 1819—Lavas and breccias—Flood produced by the melting of snow by lava—Glacier covered by a lava stream—Val del Bove how formed—Structure and origin of the cone of Etna—Whether the inclined sheets of lava were originally horizontal—Antiquity of Etna—Whether signs of diluvial waves are observable on Etna.

External appearance of Etna—Side cones—Their gradual disappearance—Early eruptions—Monti Rossi in 1669—Towns inundated by lava—Part of Catania inundated—How a lava flow advances—Underground caverns—Marine layers at the base of Etna—Val del Bove not an ancient crater—Its landscape—Shape, composition, and origin of the dikes—Linear arrangement of cones formed in 1811 and 1819—Lavas and breccias—Flood caused by melting snow from lava—Glacier covered by a lava flow—Formation of Val del Bove—Structure and origin of the cone of Etna—Whether the sloped layers of lava were originally horizontal—Age of Etna—Whether signs of flood waves can be seen on Etna.

External physiognomy of Etna.—After Vesuvius, our most authentic records relate to Etna, which rises near the sea in solitary grandeur to the height of nearly eleven thousand feet.560 The base of the cone is almost circular, and eighty-seven English miles in circumference; but if we include the whole district over which its lavas extend, the circuit is probably twice that extent.

External physiognomy of Etna.—After Vesuvius, our most reliable records pertain to Etna, which stands alone near the sea, rising to nearly eleven thousand feet in height.560 The base of the cone is nearly circular, with a circumference of eighty-seven English miles; however, if we consider the entire area covered by its lava flows, the circuit is likely twice that size.

Divided into three regions.—The cone is divided by nature into three distinct zones, called the fertile, the woody, and the desert regions. The first of these, comprising the delightful country around the skirts of the mountain, is well cultivated, thickly inhabited, and covered with olives, 397 vines, corn, fruit-trees, and aromatic herbs. Higher up, the woody region encircles the mountain—an extensive forest six or seven miles in width, affording pasturage for numerous flocks. The trees are of various species, the chestnut, oak, and pine being most luxuriant; while in some tracts are groves of cork and beech. Above the forest is the desert region, a waste of black lava and scoriæ; where, on a kind of plain, rises a cone of eruption to the height of about eleven hundred feet, from which sulphureous vapors are continually evolved.

Divided into three regions.—The cone is naturally divided into three distinct zones, known as the fertile, the woody, and the desert regions. The first zone, surrounding the base of the mountain, is well-farmed, densely populated, and filled with olive trees, 397 grapevines, grains, fruit trees, and aromatic herbs. Higher up, the woody region encircles the mountain—an extensive forest six or seven miles wide, providing grazing land for many flocks. The trees vary in species, with chestnuts, oaks, and pines being the most abundant; some areas also have groves of cork and beech. Above the forest lies the desert region, a barren expanse of black lava and ash; where, on a sort of plateau, rises a volcanic cone about eleven hundred feet tall, constantly emitting sulfurous vapors.

Cones produced by lateral eruption.—The most grand and original feature in the physiognomy of Etna is the multitude of minor cones which are distributed over its flanks, and which are most abundant in the woody region. These, although they appear but trifling irregularities when viewed from a distance as subordinate parts of so imposing and colossal a mountain, would, nevertheless, be deemed hills of considerable altitude in almost any other region. Without enumerating numerous monticules of ashes thrown out at different points, there are about eighty of these secondary volcanoes, of considerable dimensions; fifty-two on the west and north, and twenty-seven on the east side of Etna. One of the largest, called Monte Minardo, near Bronte, is upwards of 700 feet in height, and a double hill near Nicolosi, called Monti Rossi, formed in 1669, is 450 feet high, and the base two miles in circumference; so that it somewhat exceeds in size Monte Nuovo, before described. Yet it ranks only as a cone of the second magnitude amongst those produced by the lateral eruptions of Etna. On looking down from the lower borders of the desert region, these volcanoes present us with one of the most delightful and characteristic scenes in Europe. They afford every variety of height and size, and are arranged in beautiful and picturesque groups. However uniform they may appear when seen from the sea, or the plains below, nothing can be more diversified than their shape when we look from above into their craters, one side of which is generally broken down. There are, indeed, few objects in nature more picturesque than a wooded volcanic crater. The cones situated in the higher parts of the forest zone are chiefly clothed with lofty pines; while those at a lower elevation are adorned with chestnuts, oaks, beech, and holm.

Cones produced by lateral eruption.—The most impressive and unique feature of Etna's landscape is the large number of smaller cones scattered across its slopes, especially in the forested areas. While they may seem like minor irregularities from a distance, appearing as secondary elements of such an enormous and majestic mountain, they would be considered significant hills in nearly any other location. Without counting the numerous mounds of ash ejected at various points, there are about eighty of these secondary volcanoes, all of substantial size; fifty-two on the west and north sides, and twenty-seven on the east side of Etna. One of the largest, called Monte Minardo, near Bronte, stands over 700 feet tall, and a double hill near Nicolosi, known as Monti Rossi, formed in 1669, is 450 feet high with a base two miles in circumference; it is slightly larger than Monte Nuovo, previously mentioned. Yet, it is only classified as a cone of secondary importance among those created by the lateral eruptions of Etna. Looking down from the lower edges of the barren region, these volcanoes offer one of the most beautiful and distinctive views in Europe. They display a variety of heights and sizes, arranged in charming and picturesque clusters. Regardless of how uniform they seem when viewed from the sea or the plains below, their shapes are incredibly varied when we look down into their craters, one side of which is typically collapsed. Indeed, few natural sights are more striking than a wooded volcanic crater. The cones located in the higher parts of the forest zone are primarily covered in tall pines, while those at lower elevations are adorned with chestnuts, oaks, beeches, and holm oaks.

Successive obliteration of these cones.—The history of the eruptions of Etna, imperfect and interrupted as it is, affords us, nevertheless, much insight into the manner in which the whole mountain has successively attained its present magnitude and internal structure. The principal cone has more than once fallen in and been reproduced. In 1444 it was 320 feet high, and fell in after the earthquakes of 1537. In the year 1693, when a violent earthquake shook the whole of Sicily, and killed sixty thousand persons, the cone lost so much of its height, says Boccone, that it could not be seen from several places in Valdemone, from which it was before visible. The greater number of eruptions happen either from the great crater, or from lateral openings in the desert region. When hills are thrown up in the middle zone, and project beyond the 398 general level, they gradually lose their height during subsequent eruptions; for when lava runs down from the upper parts of the mountain, and encounters any of these hills, the stream is divided, and flows round them so as to elevate the gently sloping grounds from which they rise. In this manner a deduction is often made at once of twenty or thirty feet, or even more, from their height. Thus, one of the minor cones, called Monte Peluso, was diminished in altitude by a great lava stream which encircled it in 1444; and another current has recently taken the same course—yet this hill still remains four or five hundred feet high.

Successive collapse of these cones.—The history of Etna's eruptions, while incomplete and sporadic, still gives us valuable insights into how the entire mountain has gradually developed its current size and internal structure. The main cone has collapsed and been rebuilt multiple times. In 1444, it stood at 320 feet tall before collapsing after the earthquakes of 1537. In 1693, a massive earthquake struck all of Sicily, claiming the lives of sixty thousand people. According to Boccone, the cone lost so much height that it could no longer be seen from several locations in Valdemone where it had been visible before. Most eruptions occur either from the main crater or from side openings in the barren area. When hills form in the middle zone and rise above the general level, they gradually lose height during further eruptions. As lava flows down from the higher parts of the mountain and meets these hills, it splits and flows around them, causing the gently sloping ground to rise. This can result in an immediate reduction of twenty or thirty feet, or even more, from their height. For example, one of the smaller cones, called Monte Peluso, lost elevation due to a massive lava flow that surrounded it in 1444; another similar flow has recently followed the same path—yet this hill still stands four or five hundred feet high.

There is a cone called Monte Nucilla near Nicolosi, round the base of which several successive currents have flowed, and showers of ashes have fallen, since the time of history, till at last, during an eruption in 1536, the surrounding plain was so raised, that the top of the cone alone was left projecting above the general level. Monte Nero, situated above the Grotta dell' Capre, was in 1766 almost submerged by a current: and Monte Capreolo afforded, in the year 1669, a curious example of one of the last stages of obliteration; for a lava stream, descending on a high ridge which had been built up by the continued superposition of successive lavas, flowed directly into the crater, and nearly filled it. The lava, therefore, of each new lateral cone tends to detract from the relative height of lower cones above their base: so that the flanks of Etna, sloping with a gentle inclination, envelop in succession a great multitude of minor volcanoes, while new ones spring up from time to time.

There’s a cone called Monte Nucilla near Nicolosi, around the base of which several lava flows and ash falls have occurred throughout history. Eventually, during an eruption in 1536, the surrounding plain was raised so much that only the top of the cone was left standing above the general level. Monte Nero, located above the Grotta dell' Capre, was almost completely covered by a lava flow in 1766. Additionally, Monte Capreolo provided an interesting example of one of the last stages of being buried in 1669; a lava stream, flowing down a high ridge built up by layers of lava, entered the crater and nearly filled it. This means that each new lateral cone tends to reduce the relative height of the lower cones above their base. As a result, the flanks of Etna, which slope gently, cover a large number of smaller volcanoes, while new ones occasionally arise.

Early eruptions of Etna.—Etna appears to have been in activity from the earliest times of tradition; for Diodorus Siculus mentions an eruption which caused a district to be deserted by the Sicani before the Trojan war. Thucydides informs us, that in the sixth year of the Peloponnesian war, or in the spring of the year 425 B. C., a lava stream ravaged the environs of Catania, and this he says was the third eruption which had happened in Sicily since the colonization of that island by the Greeks.561 The second of the three eruptions alluded to by the historian took place in the year 475 B. C., and was that so poetically described by Pindar, two years afterwards, in his first Pythian ode:—

Early eruptions of Etna.—Etna seems to have been active since ancient times; Diodorus Siculus mentions an eruption that forced the Sicani to abandon the area before the Trojan war. Thucydides tells us that in the sixth year of the Peloponnesian war, or in the spring of 425 BCE, a lava flow devastated the surroundings of Catania, noting that this was the third eruption to occur in Sicily since the Greeks settled there.561 The second of the three eruptions referenced by the historian happened in 475 BCE, which was poetically described by Pindar two years later in his first Pythian ode:—

κιον Δ' ουρανια συνεχει Νιφοεσς' Αιτνα, πανετες Χιονος οξειας τιθηνα.

In these and the seven verses which follow, a graphic description is given of Etna, such as it appeared five centuries before the Christian era, and such as it has been seen when in eruption in modern times. The poet is only making a passing allusion to the Sicilian volcano, as the mountain under which Typhœus lay buried, yet by a few touches of his master-hand every striking feature of the scene has been faithfully portrayed. 399 We are told of "the snowy Etna, the pillar of heaven—the nurse of everlasting frost, in whose deep caverns lie concealed the fountains of unapproachable fire—a stream of eddying smoke by day—a bright and ruddy flame by night; and burning rocks rolled down with loud uproar into the sea."

In these verses and the seven that follow, there's a vivid description of Etna, as it looked five centuries before Christ and as it has been seen during eruptions in modern times. The poet makes a brief reference to the Sicilian volcano, where Typhœus was buried, but through a few skilled details, every striking aspect of the scene has been captured accurately. 399 We hear about "the snowy Etna, the pillar of heaven—the source of everlasting frost, hiding deep in its caverns the springs of unreachable fire—a swirling stream of smoke during the day—a bright and fiery flame at night; and burning rocks crash loudly into the sea."

Fig. 46.Minor cones on the flanks of Etna.

Minor cones on the flanks of Etna.

1. Monti Rossi, near Nicolosi, formed in 1669.           2. Vampeluso?562

Minor cones on the flanks of Etna.

1. Monti Rossi, near Nicolosi, formed in 1669.           2. Vampeluso?562

Eruption of 1669—Monti Rossi formed.—The great eruption which happened in the year 1669 is the first which claims particular attention. An earthquake had levelled to the ground all the houses in Nicolosi, a town situated near the lower margin of the woody region, about twenty miles from the summit of Etna, and ten from the sea at Catania. Two gulfs then opened near that town, from whence sand and scoriæ were thrown up in such quantity, that in the course of three or four months a double cone was formed, called Monti Rossi, about 450 feet high. But the most extraordinary phenomenon occurred at the commencement of the convulsion in the plain of S. Lio. A fissure six feet broad, and of unknown depth, opened with a loud crash, and ran in a somewhat tortuous course to within a mile of the summit of Etna. Its direction was from north to south, and its length twelve miles. It emitted a most vivid light. Five other parallel fissures of considerable length afterwards opened, one after the other, and emitted smoke, and gave out bellowing sounds which were heard at the distance of forty miles. This case seems to present the geologist with an illustration of the manner in which those continuous dikes of vertical porphyry were formed, which are seen to traverse some of the older lavas of Etna; for the light emitted from the great rent of S. Lio appears to indicate that the fissure was filled to a certain height with incandescent lava, probably to the height of an orifice not far distant from Monti Rossi, which at that time opened and poured out a lava current. When the melted matter in such a rent 400 has cooled, it must become a solid wall or dike, intersecting the older rocks of which the mountain is composed; similar rents have been observed during subsequent eruptions, as in 1832, when they ran in all directions from the centre of the volcano. It has been justly remarked by M. Elie de Beaumont, that such star-shaped fractures may indicate a slight upheaval of the whole of Etna. They may be the signs of the stretching of the mass, which may thus be raised gradually by a force from below.563

Eruption of 1669—Monti Rossi formed.—The major eruption that occurred in 1669 is the first one that deserves special attention. An earthquake had destroyed all the houses in Nicolosi, a town located near the edge of the wooded area, about twenty miles from the summit of Etna and ten miles from the sea at Catania. Two cracks then opened near that town, from which sand and scoria were ejected in such abundance that, over the course of three or four months, a double cone was formed, known as Monti Rossi, about 450 feet high. However, the most remarkable event took place at the start of the convulsion in the plain of S. Lio. A fissure six feet wide, and of unknown depth, opened with a loud crash and ran in a somewhat winding path for nearly a mile towards the summit of Etna. Its direction was north to south, stretching twelve miles long. It emitted a very bright light. Five other long parallel fissures opened up one after the other, releasing smoke and producing booming sounds that could be heard from forty miles away. This situation seems to provide geologists with an example of how those continuous vertical dikes of porphyry formed, which can be seen breaking through some of the older lavas of Etna; for the light from the major rift of S. Lio suggests that the fissure was filled to a certain height with molten lava, likely up to an opening not far from Monti Rossi, which at that time erupted and released a lava flow. Once the melted material in such a rift cools, it becomes a solid wall or dike intersecting the older rocks of the mountain. Similar fissures have been observed in later eruptions, such as in 1832 when they spread out in all directions from the center of the volcano. M. Elie de Beaumont rightly noted that such star-shaped fractures could indicate a slight uplift of the entire Etna. They might be signs of the mass stretching, possibly being gradually raised by forces from below.400

The lava current of 1669, before alluded to, soon reached in its course a minor cone called Mompiliere, at the base of which it entered a subterranean grotto, communicating with a suite of those caverns which are so common in the lavas of Etna. Here it appears to have melted down some of the vaulted foundations of the hill, so that the whole of that cone became slightly depressed and traversed by numerous open fissures.

The lava flow of 1669, previously mentioned, quickly reached a small cone called Mompiliere, where it entered an underground cave that connects to a series of caverns commonly found in the lavas of Etna. It seems to have melted some of the arched foundations of the hill, causing the entire cone to become slightly lowered and crisscrossed by many open cracks.

Part of Catania destroyed.—The lava, after overflowing fourteen towns and villages, some having a population of between three and four thousand inhabitants, arrived at length at the walls of Catania. These had been purposely raised to protect the city; but the burning flood accumulated till it rose to the top of the rampart, which was sixty feet in height, and then it fell in a fiery cascade and overwhelmed part of the city. The wall, however, was not thrown down, but was discovered long afterwards by excavations made in the rock by the Prince of Biscari; so that the traveller may now see the solid lava curling over the top of the rampart as if still in the very act of falling.

Part of Catania destroyed.—The lava, after overflowing fourteen towns and villages, some with populations between three and four thousand people, eventually reached the walls of Catania. These walls had been built to protect the city, but the molten flow built up until it rose to the top of the rampart, which stood sixty feet tall, and then it cascaded down in a fiery torrent, engulfing part of the city. However, the wall itself wasn’t toppled; it was discovered long afterwards through excavations in the rock by the Prince of Biscari, so travelers can now see the solid lava curling over the top of the rampart as if it’s still in the act of falling.

This great current performed the first thirteen miles of its course in twenty days, or at the rate of 162 feet per hour, but required twenty-three days for the last two miles, giving a velocity of only twenty-two feet per hour; and we learn from Dolomieu that the stream moved during part of its course at the rate of 1500 feet an hour, and in others it took several days to cover a few yards.564 When it entered the sea it was still six hundred yards broad, and forty feet deep. It covered some territories in the environs of Catania which had never before been visited by the lavas of Etna. While moving on, its surface was in general a mass of solid rock; and its mode of advancing, as is usual with lava streams, was by the occasional fissuring of the solid walls. A gentleman of Catania, named Pappalardo, desiring to secure the city from the approach of the threatening torrent, went out with a party of fifty men whom he had dressed in skins to protect them from the heat, and armed with iron crows and hooks. They broke open one of the solid walls which flanked the current near Belpasso, and immediately forth issued a rivulet of melted matter which took the direction of Paternó; but the inhabitants of that town, being alarmed for their safety, took up arms and put a stop to farther operations.565

This powerful current traveled the first thirteen miles of its path in twenty days, averaging about 162 feet per hour, but took twenty-three days to cover the last two miles, slowing down to just twenty-two feet per hour. We learn from Dolomieu that at times the stream moved at a rate of 1500 feet per hour, while at other times it took several days to cover just a few yards.564 When it reached the sea, it was still six hundred yards wide and forty feet deep. It covered some areas near Catania that had never been affected by Etna's lava before. Overall, its surface was solid rock, and like most lava streams, it advanced by periodically cracking its solid edges. A man from Catania named Pappalardo wanted to protect the city from the approaching flow, so he gathered a group of fifty men, dressed them in animal skins for protection against the heat, and equipped them with iron crowbars and hooks. They broke open one of the solid walls alongside the current near Belpasso, causing a stream of molten material to flow toward Paternó. However, the residents of that town, fearing for their safety, took up arms and halted any further efforts.565

401 As another illustration of the solidity of the walls of an advancing lava stream, I may mention an adventure related by Recupero, who, in 1766, had ascended a small hill formed of ancient volcanic matter, to behold the slow and gradual approach of a fiery current, two miles and a half broad; when suddenly two small threads of liquid matter issuing from a crevice detached themselves from the main stream, and ran rapidly towards the hill. He and his guide had just time to escape, when they saw the hill, which was fifty feet in height, surrounded, and in a quarter of an hour melted down into the burning mass, so as to flow on with it.

401 To illustrate how solid the walls of an advancing lava flow can be, I’ll share a story told by Recupero, who in 1766 climbed a small hill made of ancient volcanic material to witness the slow and steady approach of a fiery current that was two and a half miles wide. Suddenly, two small streams of molten material broke off from the main flow and quickly headed towards the hill. He and his guide barely managed to escape when they saw the fifty-foot-high hill being surrounded and, within a quarter of an hour, completely melted down into the blazing mass, flowing along with it.

But it must not be supposed that this complete fusion of rocky matter coming in contact with lava is of universal, or even common, occurrence. It probably happens when fresh portions of incandescent matter come successively in contact with fusible materials. In many of the dikes which intersect the tuffs and lavas of Etna, there is scarcely any perceptible alteration effected by heat on the edges of the horizontal beds, in contact with the vertical and more crystalline mass. On the side of Mompiliere, one of the towns overflowed in the great eruption above described, an excavation was made in 1704; and by immense labor the workmen reached, at the depth of thirty-five feet, the gate of the principal church, where there were three statues, held in high veneration. One of these, together with a bell, some money, and other articles, were extracted in a good state of preservation from beneath a great arch formed by the lava. It seems very extraordinary that any works of art, not encased with tuff, like those in Herculaneum, should have escaped fusion in hollow spaces left open in this lava-current, which was so hot at Catania eight years after it entered the town, that it was impossible to hold the hand in some of the crevices.

But it shouldn’t be thought that this complete mixing of rock material with lava happens everywhere, or even often. It probably occurs when new batches of molten material come into contact with meltable substances. In many of the dikes that cut through the tuffs and lavas of Etna, there’s hardly any noticeable change caused by heat along the edges of the horizontal layers that touch the vertical, more crystalline mass. On the side of Mompiliere, one of the towns affected by the major eruption mentioned earlier, an excavation was done in 1704; and after a lot of effort, the workers reached, at a depth of thirty-five feet, the entrance of the main church, which contained three highly revered statues. One of these, along with a bell, some coins, and other items, was recovered in good condition from beneath a large arch formed by the lava. It’s quite remarkable that any artworks, not encased in tuff like those in Herculaneum, could have survived melting in the hollow spaces left open in this lava flow, which was so hot in Catania eight years after it entered the town that it was impossible to hold a hand in some of the cracks.

Subterranean caverns on Etna.—Mention was made of the entrance of a lava-stream into a subterranean grotto, whereby the foundations of a hill were partially undermined. Such underground passages are among the most curious features on Etna, and appear to have been produced by the hardening of the lava, during the escape of great volumes of elastic fluids, which are often discharged for many days in succession, after the crisis of the eruption is over. Near Nicolosi, not far from Monti Rossi, one of these great openings may be seen, called the Fossa della Palomba, 625 feet in circumference at its mouth, and seventy-eight deep. After reaching the bottom of this, we enter another dark cavity, and then others in succession, sometimes descending precipices by means of ladders. At length the vaults terminate in a great gallery ninety feet long, and from fifteen to fifty broad, beyond which there is still a passage, never yet explored; so that the extent of these caverns remains unknown.566 The walls and roofs of these great vaults are composed of rough and bristling scoriæ, of the most fantastic forms.

Subterranean caverns on Etna.—There was a mention of a lava flow entering a hidden grotto, which partially undermined the base of a hill. These underground passages are some of the most fascinating features on Etna, formed by the cooling of lava during the release of large amounts of gas that often continues for many days after an eruption is over. Near Nicolosi, not far from Monti Rossi, you can see one of these large openings, called the Fossa della Palomba, which has a circumference of 625 feet at its entrance and is seventy-eight feet deep. Once you reach the bottom, you enter another dark space, followed by more chambers, sometimes descending steep areas with ladders. Eventually, the vaults end in a large gallery that is ninety feet long and between fifteen and fifty feet wide, beyond which lies an uncharted passage; as a result, the full extent of these caverns remains unknown.566 The walls and ceilings of these massive vaults are made up of rough and jagged scoria in the most bizarre shapes.

Marine strata at base of Etna.—If we skirt the fertile region at the 402 base of Etna on its southern and eastern sides, we behold marine strata of clay sand, and volcanic tuff, cropping out from beneath the modern lavas. The marine fossil shells occurring in these strata are all of them, or nearly all, identical with species now inhabiting the Mediterranean; and as they appear at the height of from 600 to 800 feet above the sea near Catania, they clearly prove that there has been in this region, as in other parts of Sicily farther to the south, an upward movement of the ancient bed of the sea. It is fair, therefore, to infer that the whole mountain, with the exception of those parts which are of very modern origin, has participated in this upheaval.

Marine layers at the base of Etna.—If we go around the fertile area at the 402 base of Etna on its southern and eastern sides, we can see marine layers of clay, sand, and volcanic tuff, showing beneath the modern lavas. The marine fossil shells found in these layers are all, or nearly all, the same as species currently living in the Mediterranean; and since they appear at heights of 600 to 800 feet above sea level near Catania, they clearly indicate that there has been an upward movement of the ancient sea bed in this region, similar to other parts of Sicily further south. Therefore, it is reasonable to conclude that the entire mountain, except for those areas formed very recently, has experienced this uplift.

If we view Etna from the south, we see the marine deposits above alluded to, forming a low line of hills (e, e, Fig. 47), or a steep inland slope or cliff (f), as in the annexed drawing taken from the limestone platform of Primosole. It should be observed however, in reference to this view, that the height of the volcanic cone is ten times greater than the hills at its base (e, e), although it appears less elevated, because the summit of the cone is ten or twelve times more distant from the plain of Catania than is Licodia.

If we look at Etna from the south, we can see the marine deposits mentioned earlier, forming a low line of hills (e, e, Fig. 47), or a steep slope or cliff inland (f), as shown in the drawing taken from the limestone platform of Primosole. It's important to note, regarding this view, that the volcanic cone is ten times taller than the hills at its base (e, e), even though it seems less elevated because the top of the cone is ten to twelve times further away from the plain of Catania than Licodia is.

Fig. 47.View of Etna from the summit of the limestone platform of Primosole.

View of Etna from the summit of the limestone platform of Primosole.

View of Etna from the top of the limestone platform at Primosole.

a, Highest cone.      b, Montagnuola.

c, Monte Minardo, with smaller lateral cones above.

c, Monte Minardo, featuring smaller side cones above.

d, Town of Licodia dei Monaci.

d, Town of Licodia dei Monaci.

e, Marine formation called creta, argillaceous and sandy beds with a few shells, and associated volcanic rocks.

e, Marine formation known as chalk, clayey and sandy layers with some shells, and related volcanic rocks.

f, Escarpment of stratified subaqueous volcanic tuff, &c., northwest of Catania.

f, Escarpment of layered underwater volcanic tuff, etc., northwest of Catania.

g, Town of Catania.

g, City of Catania.

h i, Dotted line expressing the highest boundary along which the marine strata are occasionally seen.

h i, Dotted line showing the upper limit where the marine layers can sometimes be observed.

k, Plain of Catania.

k, Catania Plain.

l, Limestone platform of Primosole of the Newer Pliocene period.

l, Limestone platform of Primosole from the Late Pliocene period.

m, La Motta di Catania.

La Motta di Catania.

The mountain is in general of a very symmetrical form, a flattened cone broken on its eastern side, by a deep valley, called the Val del Bove, or in the provincial dialect of the peasants, "Val di Bué," for here the herdsman

The mountain generally has a very symmetrical shape, resembling a flattened cone that is disrupted on its eastern side by a deep valley known as the Val del Bove, or in the local dialect of the peasants, "Val di Bué," because here the herdsman

"in the reduced valley of mooing" Watching over wandering flocks.

Dr. Buckland was, I believe, the first English geologist who examined this valley with attention, and I am indebted to him for having described it to me, before I visited Sicily, as more worthy of attention than any single spot in that island, or perhaps in Europe.

Dr. Buckland was, I believe, the first English geologist to closely examine this valley, and I’m thankful to him for describing it to me before I visited Sicily, as being more deserving of attention than any single location in that island, or maybe even in Europe.

PLATE III.

PLATE 3.

VIEW LOOKING UP THE VAL DEL BOVE, ETNA.

VIEW LOOKING UP THE VAL DEL BOVE, ETNA.

VIEW LOOKING UP THE VAL DEL BOVE, ETNA.

The Val del Bove commences near the summit of Etna, and descending 403 into the woody region, is farther continued on one side by a second and narrower valley, called the Val di Calanna. Below this another, named the Val di St. Giacomo, begins,—a long narrow ravine, which is prolonged to the neighborhood of Zaffarana (e, fig. 48), on the confines of the fertile region. These natural incisions into the side of the volcano are of such depth that they expose to view a great part of the structure of the entire mass, which, in the Val del Bove, is laid open to the depth of from 3000 to above 4000 feet from the summit of Etna. The geologist thus enjoys an opportunity of ascertaining how far the internal conformation of the cone corresponds with what he might have anticipated as the result of that mode of increase which has been witnessed during the historical era.

The Val del Bove starts near the top of Mount Etna and, as it goes down into the wooded area, it continues on one side with a second, narrower valley called the Val di Calanna. Below this, another valley, named the Val di St. Giacomo, begins—a long, narrow ravine that stretches toward the area near Zaffarana (e, fig. 48), at the edge of the fertile land. These natural cuts into the volcano's side are so deep that they reveal a significant part of the entire structure, which in the Val del Bove is exposed to depths of 3000 to over 4000 feet from the summit of Etna. This gives geologists a chance to see how much the internal formation of the cone matches what they might have expected from the growth observed during historical times.

Fig. 48.Great valley on the east side of Etna.

Great valley on the east side of Etna.

Great valley on the east side of Etna.

a, Highest cone. b, Montagnuola.
c, Head of Val del Bove. d, d, Serre del Solfizio.
e, Village of Zaffarana on the lower border of the woody region.
f, One of the lateral cones. g, Monti Rossi.

Description of Plate III.—The accompanying view (Pl. III.) is part of a panoramic sketch which I made in November, 1828, and may assist the reader in comprehending some topographical details to be alluded to in the sequel, although it can convey no idea of the picturesque grandeur of the scene.

Description of Plate III.—The accompanying view (Pl. III.) is part of a panoramic sketch I created in November 1828, and it may help the reader understand some of the topographical details that will be mentioned later, although it can't capture the picturesque grandeur of the scene.

The great lava-currents of 1819 and 1811 are seen pouring down from the higher parts of the valley, overrunning the forests of the great plain, and rising up in the foreground on the left with a rugged surface, on which many hillocks and depressions appear, such as often characterize a lava-current immediately after its consolidation.

The massive lava flows of 1819 and 1811 are seen rushing down from the higher areas of the valley, covering the forests of the vast plain, and rising up in the foreground on the left with a rough surface, marked by many mounds and dips that are typical of a lava flow soon after it hardens.

The small cone, No. 7, was formed in 1811, and was still smoking when I saw it in 1828. The other small volcano to the left, from which vapor is issuing, was, I believe, one of those formed in 1819.

The small cone, No. 7, was created in 1811 and was still smoking when I saw it in 1828. The other small volcano on the left, which is releasing vapor, was, I think, one of those formed in 1819.

The following are the names of some of the other points indicated in the sketch:—

The following are the names of some of the other points shown in the sketch:—

1, Montagnuola. 5, Finocchio. 9, Musara.
2, Torre del Filosofo. 6, Capra. 10, Zocolaro.
3, Highest cone. 7, Cone of 1811. 11, Rocca di Calanna.
4, Lepra. 8, Cima del Asino.  

Description of Plate IV.—The second view (Pl. IV.) represents the same valley as seen from above, or looking directly down the Val del Bove, from the summit of the principal crater formed in 1819.567 I am 404 unable to point out the precise spot which this crater would occupy in the view represented in Plate III.; but I conceive that it would appear in the face of the great precipice, near which the smoke issuing from the cone No. 7 is made to terminate. There are many ledges of rock on the face of that precipice where eruptions have occurred.

Description of Plate 4.—The second view (Pl. IV.) shows the same valley from above, looking directly down the Val del Bove from the top of the main crater that formed in 1819.567 I can't pinpoint the exact location of this crater in the view shown in Plate III.; however, I believe it would be visible on the side of the large cliff, close to where the smoke from cone No. 7 is seen ending. There are several ledges of rock on that cliff where eruptions have taken place.

The circular form of the Val del Bove is well shown in this view. (Pl. IV.) To the right and left are the lofty precipices which form the southern and northern sides of the great valley, and which are intersected by dikes projecting in the manner afterwards to be described. In the distance appears the "fertile region" of Etna, extending like a great plain along the sea-coast.

The circular shape of the Val del Bove is clearly visible in this view. (Pl. IV.) On the right and left are the tall cliffs that make up the southern and northern edges of the large valley, which are cut through by dikes that will be described later. In the background, you can see the "fertile region" of Etna, stretching like a vast plain along the coastline.

The spots particularly referred to in the plate are the following:—

The spots specifically mentioned in the image are the following:—

a, Cape Spartivento, in Italy, of which the outline is seen in the distance. b, The promontory of Taormino, on the Sicilian coast. c, The river Alcantra. d, The small village of Riposto. f, The town of Aci Reale. g, Cyclopian islands, or "Faraglioni," in the Bay of Trezza. h, The great harbor of Syracuse. k, The Lake of Lentini. i, The city of Catania, near which is marked the course of the lava which flowed from the Monti Rossi in 1669, and destroyed part of the city. l, To the left of the view is the crater of 1811, which is also shown at No. 7 in Plate III. m, Rock of Musara, also seen at No. 9 in Plate III. e, Valley of Calanna.

a, Cape Spartivento in Italy, which can be seen in the distance. b, The promontory of Taormina on the Sicilian coast. c, The Alcantara River. d, The small village of Riposto. f, The town of Aci Reale. g, Cyclopean islands, or "Faraglioni," in the Bay of Trezza. h, The large harbor of Syracuse. k, The Lake of Lentini. i, The city of Catania, near which the path of lava that flowed from Monti Rossi in 1669 is indicated, destroying part of the city. l, To the left of the view is the crater from 1811, which is also depicted at No. 7 in Plate III. m, Rock of Musara, also shown at No. 9 in Plate III. e, Valley of Calanna.

The Val del Bove is of truly magnificent dimensions, a vast amphitheatre four or five miles in diameter, surrounded by nearly vertical precipices, varying from 1000 to above 3000 feet in height, the loftiest being at the upper end, and the height gradually diminishing on both sides. The feature which first strikes the geologist as distinguishing the boundary cliffs of this valley, is the prodigious multitude of verticle dikes which are seen in all directions traversing the volcanic beds. The circular form of this great chasm, and the occurrence of these countless dikes, amounting perhaps to several thousands in number, so forcibly recalled to my mind the phenomena of the Atrio del Cavallo, on Vesuvius, that I at first imagined that I had entered a vast crater, on a scale as far exceeding that of Somma, as Etna surpasses Vesuvius in magnitude.

The Val del Bove is truly impressive, a huge amphitheater four or five miles wide, surrounded by nearly vertical cliffs ranging from 1,000 to over 3,000 feet high, with the tallest at the upper end and the height gradually decreasing on both sides. What stands out to the geologist is the incredible number of vertical dikes conspicuously crossing the volcanic layers in all directions. The round shape of this massive chasm, along with the presence of these countless dikes—possibly numbering in the thousands—strongly reminded me of the phenomena in the Atrio del Cavallo on Vesuvius. At first, I thought I had entered an enormous crater, one that far exceeds Somma, just as Etna is larger than Vesuvius.

But I was soon undeceived when I had attentively explored the different sides of the great amphitheatre, in order to satisfy myself whether the semicircular wall of the Val del Bove had ever formed the boundary of a crater, and whether the beds had the same quâquâ-versal dip which is so beautifully exhibited in the escarpment of Somma. Had the supposed analogy between Somma and the Val del Bove held true, the tufts and lavas at the head of the valley would have dipped to the west, those on the north side towards the north, and those on the southern side to the south. But such I did not find to be the inclination of the beds; they all dip towards the sea, or nearly east, as in the valleys of St. Giacomo and Calanna below.

But I quickly realized I was mistaken when I carefully examined the different sides of the great amphitheater to see if the semicircular wall of the Val del Bove had ever been the edge of a crater and whether the layers had the same dip in all directions that is so clearly shown in the Somma escarpment. If the supposed similarity between Somma and the Val del Bove were accurate, the layers and lava at the top of the valley would have sloped to the west, those on the north side toward the north, and those on the southern side to the south. However, that wasn't the angle of the layers; they all sloped toward the sea, or almost east, like in the valleys of St. Giacomo and Calanna below.

PLATE IV.

PLATE 4.

VIEW OF THE VAL DEL BOVE, ETNA,

VIEW OF THE VAL DEL BOVE, ETNA, AS SEEN FROM ABOVE, OR FROM THE CRATER OF 1819.

VIEW OF THE VAL DEL BOVE, ETNA, AS SEEN FROM ABOVE, OR FROM THE CRATER OF 1819.

405 Scenery of the Val del Bove.—Let the reader picture to himself a large amphitheatre, five miles in diameter, and surrounded on three sides by precipices from 2000 to 3000 feet in height. If he has beheld that most picturesque scene in the chain of the Pyrenees, the celebrated "cirque of Gavarnie," he may form some conception of the magnificent circle of precipitous rocks which inclose, on three sides, the great plain of the Val del Bove. This plain has been deluged by repeated streams of lava; and although it appears almost level, when viewed from a distance, it is, in fact, more uneven than the surface of the most tempestuous sea. Besides the minor irregularities of the lava, the valley is in one part interrupted by a ridge of rocks, two of which, Musara and Capra, are very prominent. It can hardly be said that they

405 Scenery of the Val del Bove.—Imagine a large amphitheater that spans five miles in diameter, flanked on three sides by steep cliffs rising between 2000 and 3000 feet. If you've seen the stunning view at the Pyrenees, particularly the famous "cirque of Gavarnie," you can start to imagine the impressive circle of steep rocks that surrounds the great plain of the Val del Bove. This plain has been covered by multiple flows of lava; and while it looks almost flat from afar, it is actually more uneven than the roughest sea. In addition to the smaller bumps in the lava, the valley is disrupted in one area by a ridge of rocks, two of which, Musara and Capra, stand out prominently. It's hard to say that they

"like giants standing" To guard magical land;

for although, like the Trosachs, in the Highlands of Scotland, they are of gigantic dimensions, and appear almost isolated, as seen from many points, yet the stern and severe grandeur of the scenery which they adorn is not such as would be selected by a poet for a vale of enchantment. The character of the scene would accord far better with Milton's picture of the infernal world; and if we imagine ourselves to behold in motion, in the darkness of the night, one of those fiery currents which have so often traversed the great valley, we may well recall

for although, like the Trosachs in the Highlands of Scotland, they are enormous and seem almost isolated from many viewpoints, the harsh and imposing beauty of the landscape they enhance wouldn’t be the choice of a poet for a magical valley. The scene would align much more with Milton's depiction of the underworld; and if we picture ourselves witnessing one of those fiery flows that have frequently moved through the great valley in the night’s darkness, we might well remember

"that bleak plain, lonely and untamed, The place of emptiness, lacking light, Save what the glow of these bright flames Casts pale and scary.

The face of the precipices already mentioned is broken in the most picturesque manner by the vertical walls of lava which traverse them. These masses visually stand out in relief, are exceedingly diversified in form, and of immense altitude. In the autumn, their black outline may often be seen relieved by clouds of fleecy vapor which settle behind them, and do not disperse until mid-day, continuing to fill the valley while the sun is shining on every other part of Sicily, and on the higher regions of Etna.

The cliffs mentioned earlier are beautifully marked by the vertical walls of lava crossing them. These formations stand out distinctly, vary greatly in shape, and are extremely tall. In the fall, their dark silhouettes can often be seen highlighted by fluffy clouds that gather behind them and don’t clear up until midday, filling the valley while the sun shines on every other part of Sicily and the higher areas of Etna.

As soon as the vapors begin to rise, the changes of scene are varied in the highest degree, different rocks being unveiled and hidden by turns, and the summit of Etna often breaking through the clouds for a moment with its dazzling snows, and being then as suddenly withdrawn from the view.

As soon as the vapors start to rise, the changes in scenery are incredibly varied, with different rocks appearing and disappearing in turns. The peak of Etna often breaks through the clouds for a moment, showcasing its dazzling snows, only to be quickly hidden from sight again.

An unusual silence prevails; for there are no torrents dashing from the rocks, nor any movement of running water in this valley such as may almost invariably be heard in mountainous regions. Every drop of water that falls from the heavens, or flows from the melting ice and snow, is instantly absorbed by the porous lava; and such is the dearth of springs, 406 that the herdsman is compelled to supply his flocks, during the hot season, from stores of snow laid up in hollows of the mountain during winter.

An unusual silence hangs in the air; there are no torrents crashing down from the rocks, nor any sound of flowing water in this valley, which is typically found in mountainous places. Every drop of rain or water from melting ice and snow is quickly soaked up by the porous lava. Because there are so few springs, 406 the herdsman has to provide water for his flocks during the hot season using snow he collected in the mountain's hollows over the winter.

The strips of green herbage and forest land, which have here and there escaped the burning lavas, serve, by contrast, to heighten the desolation of the scene. When I visited the valley, nine years after the eruption of 1819, I saw hundreds of trees, or rather the white skeletons of trees, on the borders of the black lava, the trunks and branches being all leafless, and deprived of their bark by the scorching heat emitted from the melted rock; an image recalling those beautiful lines:—

The patches of green grass and forest that have, here and there, survived the flowing lava make the desolation of the scene even more striking. When I visited the valley, nine years after the eruption of 1819, I saw hundreds of trees, or rather the white skeletons of trees, at the edges of the black lava. The trunks and branches were all leafless and stripped of their bark by the intense heat from the molten rock; it brought to mind those beautiful lines:—

"As when the sky's fire" Has damaged the forest oaks or mountain pines, With scorched tops, their tall growth stands, even though bare, Stands on the barren land.
Fig. 49.Dikes at the base of the Serre del Solfizio, Etna.

Dikes at the base of the Serre del Solfizio, Etna.

Dikes at the foot of the Serre del Solfizio, Etna.

Form, composition, and origin of the dikes.—But without indulging the imagination any longer in descriptions of scenery, I may observe that the dikes before mentioned form unquestionably the most interesting geological phenomenon in the Val del Bove. Some of these are composed of trachyte, others of compact blue basalt with olivine. They vary in breadth from two to twenty feet and upwards, and usually project from the face of the cliffs, as represented in the annexed drawing (fig. 49). They consist of harder materials than the strata which they traverse, and therefore waste away less rapidly under the influence of that repeated 407 congelation and thawing to which the rocks in this zone of Etna are exposed. The dikes are for the most part vertical, but sometimes they run in a tortuous course through the tuffs and breccias, as represented in fig. 50. In the escarpment of Somma, where similar walls of lava cut through alternating beds of sand and scoriæ, a coating of coal-black rock, approaching in its nature and appearance to pitchstone, is seen at the contact of the dike with the intersected beds. I did not observe such parting layers at the junction of the Etnean dikes which I examined, but they may perhaps be discoverable.

Form, composition, and origin of the dikes.—Without getting lost in descriptions of the scenery, I should point out that the dikes mentioned earlier are definitely the most fascinating geological feature in the Val del Bove. Some of these are made of trachyte, while others consist of solid blue basalt containing olivine. Their width ranges from two to over twenty feet and they typically stick out from the cliff faces, as shown in the attached drawing (fig. 49). They are made of harder materials than the layers they cut through, so they erode more slowly due to the constant freeze-thaw cycles that the rocks in this area of Etna experience. Most of the dikes are vertical, but sometimes they twist and turn through the tuffs and breccias, as illustrated in fig. 50. In the Somma escarpment, where similar lava walls cut through alternating layers of sand and scoria, a layer of coal-black rock, resembling pitchstone in both composition and appearance, is found at the junction between the dike and the layers it intersects. I didn't notice any such separation layers at the meeting points of the Etna dikes I examined, but they might be present elsewhere.

Fig. 50.Tortuous veins of lava at Punto di Giumento, Etna.

Tortuous veins of lava at Punto di Giumento, Etna.

Tangled lava flows at Punto di Giumento, Etna.

The geographical position of these dikes is most interesting, as they are very numerous near the head of the Val del Bove, where the cones of 1811 and 1819 were thrown up, as also in that zone of the mountain where lateral eruptions are frequent; whereas in the valley of Calanna, which is below that parallel, and in a region where lateral eruptions are extremely rare, scarcely any dikes are seen, and none whatever still lower in the valley of St. Giacomo. This is precisely what we might have expected, if we consider the vertical fissures now filled with rock to have been the feeders of lateral cones, or, in other words, the channels which gave passage to the lava-currents and scoriæ that have issued from vents in the forest zone. In other parts of Etna there may be numerous dikes at as low a level as the Valley of Calanna, because the line of lateral eruptions is not everywhere at the same height above the sea; but in the section above alluded to, there appeared to me an obvious connection between the frequency of dikes and of lateral eruptions.

The geographical location of these dikes is quite fascinating, as they are very numerous near the head of the Val del Bove, where the cones formed during the eruptions of 1811 and 1819, as well as in that area of the mountain where lateral eruptions frequently occur. In contrast, in the Calanna valley, which is below that parallel and in a region where lateral eruptions are extremely rare, hardly any dikes are visible, and none at all are found further down in the St. Giacomo valley. This aligns with what one might expect if we consider the vertical fissures now filled with rock to have been the sources for the lateral cones, or in other words, the pathways that allowed lava flows and scoria to emerge from vents in the forest zone. In other areas of Etna, there might be many dikes at elevations as low as the Calanna valley, because the line of lateral eruptions doesn’t occur at the same height above sea level everywhere; however, in the section mentioned, there seems to be a clear link between the occurrence of dikes and lateral eruptions.

Some fissures may have been filled from above, but I did not see any which, by terminating downwards, gave proof of such an origin. Almost all the isolated masses in the Val del Bove, such as Capra, Musara, and others, are traversed by dikes, and may, perhaps, have partly owed their preservation to that circumstance, if at least the action of occasional floods has been one of the destroying causes in the Val del Bove; for there is nothing which affords so much protection to a mass of strata against the undermining action of running water as a perpendicular dike of hard rock.

Some cracks may have been filled from the top, but I didn't see any that ended downwards, proving that kind of origin. Almost all the isolated formations in the Val del Bove, like Capra, Musara, and others, are cut by dikes and might have partly survived because of that, especially if occasional floods have been one of the destructive forces in the Val del Bove. After all, nothing offers as much protection to a layer of rock against the eroding force of flowing water as a vertical dike of hard rock.

408 In the accompanying drawing (fig. 51), the flowing of the lavas of 1811 and 1819, between the rocks Finochio, Capra, and Musara, is represented. The height of the two last-mentioned isolated masses has been much diminished by the elevation of their base, caused by these currents. They may, perhaps, be the remnants of lateral cones which existed before the Val del Bove was formed, and may hereafter be once more buried by the lavas that are now accumulating in the valley.

408 In the accompanying drawing (fig. 51), the flow of the lava from 1811 and 1819, between the rocks Finochio, Capra, and Musara, is shown. The height of the last two isolated peaks has been significantly reduced due to the rise of their base, caused by these lava flows. They might be the remnants of side cones that existed before the Val del Bove was created and could eventually be buried again by the lava currently building up in the valley.

Fig. 51.View of the rocks Finochio, Capra, and Musara, Val del Bove.

View of the rocks Finochio, Capra, and Musara, Val del Bove.

View of the Finochio, Capra, and Musara rocks, Val del Bove.

From no point of view are the dikes more conspicuous than from the summit of the highest cone of Etna; a view of some of them is given in the annexed drawing. (Fig. 52.)

From no perspective are the dikes more noticeable than from the top of the highest cone of Etna; a view of some of them is shown in the drawing below. (Fig. 52.)

Eruption of 1811.—I have alluded to the streams of lava which were poured forth in 1811 and 1819. Gemmellaro, who witnessed these eruptions, informs us that the great crater in 1811 first testified by its loud detonations that a column of lava had ascended to near the summit of the mountain. A violent shock was then felt, and a stream broke out from the side of the cone, at no great distance from its apex. Shortly after this had ceased to flow, a second stream burst forth at another opening, considerably below the first; then a third still lower, and so on till seven different issues had been thus successively formed, all lying upon the same straight line. It has been supposed that this line was a perpendicular rent in the internal framework of the mountain, which rent was probably not produced at one shock, but prolonged successively downwards, by the lateral pressure and intense heat of the internal column of lava, as it subsided by gradual discharge through each vent.568

Eruption of 1811.—I mentioned the lava flows that occurred in 1811 and 1819. Gemmellaro, who observed these eruptions, tells us that the large crater in 1811 first indicated its activity with loud explosions, signaling that a column of lava had risen close to the top of the mountain. A powerful shock was then felt, followed by a stream of lava erupting from the side of the cone, not far from its peak. Soon after this flow stopped, a second stream erupted from a different opening, significantly lower than the first; then a third, even lower, and so on, until a total of seven separate flows had formed, all aligned in a straight line. It is believed that this line was a vertical crack in the mountain's internal structure, which likely didn’t form from a single shock but developed progressively downwards due to the lateral pressure and intense heat of the internal lava column as it gradually discharged through each opening.568

Eruption of 1819.—In 1819 three large mouths or caverns opened very near those which were formed in the eruptions of 1811, from which flames, red-hot cinders, and sand were thrown up with loud explosions. A few minutes afterwards another mouth opened below, from which 409 flames and smoke issued; and finally a fifth, lower still, whence a torrent of lava flowed, which spread itself with great velocity over the deep and broad valley called "Val del Bove." This stream flowed two miles in the first twenty-four hours, and nearly as far in the succeeding day and night. The three original mouths at length united into one large crater, and sent forth lava, as did the inferior apertures, so that an enormous torrent poured down the "Val del Bove." When it arrived at a vast and almost perpendicular precipice, at the head of the Valley of Calanna, it poured over in a cascade, and, being hardened in its descent, made an inconceivable crash as it was dashed against the bottom. So immense was the column of dust raised by the abrasion of the tufaceous hill over which the hardened mass descended, that the Catanians were in great alarm, supposing a new eruption to have burst out in the woody region, exceeding in violence that near the summit of Etna.

Eruption of 1819.—In 1819, three large openings appeared very close to those that were created during the eruptions of 1811, which spewed flames, red-hot cinders, and sand with loud explosions. A few minutes later, another opening formed below, releasing 409 flames and smoke; and finally, a fifth opening appeared even lower, from which a stream of lava flowed rapidly across the deep and wide valley known as "Val del Bove." This lava traveled two miles in the first twenty-four hours and nearly the same distance in the next day and night. The three initial openings eventually merged into one large crater, which emitted lava, as did the lower openings, creating an enormous flow down the "Val del Bove." When it reached a massive and nearly vertical cliff at the head of the Valley of Calanna, it cascaded over the edge, hardening as it fell, and generated a tremendous crash when it struck the ground below. The towering column of dust raised by the impact on the tufaceous hill was so large that the people of Catania were extremely alarmed, fearing a new eruption had begun in the wooded area that was more violent than the one near the summit of Etna.

Fig. 52.View from the summit of Etna into the Val del Bove.

View from the summit of Etna into the Val del Bove.569

View from the top of Etna into the Val del Bove.569

Mode of advance of the lava.—Of the cones thrown up during this eruption, not more than two are of sufficient magnitude to be numbered among those eighty which were before described as adorning the flanks of Etna. The surface of the lava which deluged the "Val del Bove," consists of rocky and angular blocks, tossed together in the 410 utmost disorder. Nothing can be more rugged, or more unlike the smooth and even superficies, which those who are unacquainted with volcanic countries may have pictured to themselves, in a mass of matter which had consolidated from a liquid state. Mr. Scrope observed this current in the year 1819, slowly advancing down a considerable slope, at the rate of about a yard an hour, nine months after its emission. The lower stratum being arrested by the resistance of the ground, the upper or central part gradually protruded itself, and, being unsupported, fell down. This in its turn was covered by a mass of more liquid lava, which swelled over it from above. The current had all the appearance of a huge heap of rough and large cinders rolling over and over upon itself by the effect of an extremely slow propulsion from behind. The contraction of the crust as it solidified, and the friction of the scoriform cakes against one another, produced a crackling sound. Within the crevices a dull red heat might be seen by night, and vapor issuing in considerable quantity was visible by day.570

How the lava moves.—Of the cones formed during this eruption, only two are large enough to be included in the eighty that were previously described as lining the sides of Etna. The surface of the lava that flooded the "Val del Bove" consists of rocky and angular blocks, jumbled together in complete chaos. Nothing is more ragged or more different from the smooth and even surface that those unfamiliar with volcanic areas might imagine from a solidified mass of liquid material. Mr. Scrope observed this flow in 1819, slowly moving down a significant slope at a speed of about a yard per hour, nine months after it erupted. The lower layer was halted by the ground's resistance, causing the upper or central part to gradually push out, and when it became unsupported, it fell. This was then covered by a layer of more liquid lava that flowed over it from above. The flow looked like a massive pile of rough and large cinders tumbling over itself due to an extremely slow push from behind. As the crust solidified, it contracted, and the friction between the scoriform pieces created a crackling sound. At night, a dull red heat was visible in the cracks, and during the day, vapor was seen emerging in large amounts.570

It was stated that when the lava of 1819 arrived at the head of the Valley of Calanna, after flowing down the Val del Bove, it descended in a cascade. This stream, in fact, like many previous currents of lava which have flowed down successively from the higher regions of Etna, was turned by a great promontory projecting from the southern side of the Val del Bove. This promontory consists of the hills called Zocolaro and Calanna, and of a ridge of inferior height which connects them. (See fig. 53.)

It was noted that when the lava from 1819 reached the head of the Valley of Calanna, after flowing down the Val del Bove, it became a waterfall. This flow, like many earlier flows of lava that have moved down from the higher areas of Etna, was redirected by a large cliff jutting out from the southern side of the Val del Bove. This cliff is made up of the hills known as Zocolaro and Calanna, along with a lower ridge that links them. (See fig. 53.)

Fig. 53. Zocolaro and Calanna.

A, Zocolaro.

A, Zocolaro.

B, Monte di Calanna.

B, Mount Calanna.

C, Plain at the head of the Valley of Calanna.

C, Plain at the start of the Valley of Calanna.

a, Lava of 1819 descending the precipice and flowing through the valley.

a, Lava from 1819 cascading down the cliff and moving through the valley.

b, Lavas of 1811 and 1819 flowing round the hill of Calanna.

b, Lavas from 1811 and 1819 flowing around the hill of Calanna.

It happened in 1811 and 1819 that the flows of lava overtopped the ridge intervening between the hills of Zocolaro and Calanna, so that they fell in a cascade over a lofty precipice, and began to fill up the valley of Calanna (a, fig. 53). Other portions of the same lava-current (b) flowed round the promontory, and they exhibit one of the peculiar 411 characteristics of such streams, namely that of becoming solid externally, even while yet in motion. Instead of thinning out gradually at their edges, their sides may often be compared to two rocky walls which are sometimes inclined at an angle of between thirty and forty degrees. When such streams are turned from their course by a projecting rock, they move right onwards in a new direction; and in the Valley of Calanna a considerable space has thus been left between the steep sides of the lavas b b, so deflected, and the precipitous escarpment of Zocolaro, A, which bounds the plain C.

It happened in 1811 and 1819 that lava flows overflowed the ridge between the hills of Zocolaro and Calanna, cascading over a high cliff and starting to fill the Calanna valley (a, fig. 53). Other parts of the same lava flow (b) went around the promontory and displayed one of the distinct features of such streams, which is that they become solid on the outside while still moving. Instead of gradually thinning out at their edges, their sides often resemble two rocky walls that can be angled between thirty and forty degrees. When these streams are diverted by a jutting rock, they continue on in a new direction; as a result, a significant gap has been left in the Valley of Calanna between the steep sides of the deflected lavas b b and the sheer cliff of Zocolaro, A, which borders the plain C.

Lavas and breccias.—In regard to the volcanic masses which are intersected by dikes in the Val del Bove, they consist in great part of graystone lavas, of an intermediate character between basalt and trachyte, and partly of porphyritic lava resembling trachyte, but to which that name cannot, according to Von Buch and G. Rose, be in strictness applied, because the felspar belongs to the variety called Labradorite. There is great similarity in the composition of the ancient and modern lavas of Etna, both consisting of felspar, augite, olivine, and titaniferous iron. The alternating breccias are made up of scoriæ, sand, and angular blocks of lava. Many of these fragments may have been thrown out by volcanic explosions, which, falling on the hardened surface of moving lava-currents, may have been carried to a considerable distance. It may also happen that when lava advances very slowly, in the manner of the flow of 1819, the angular masses resulting from the frequent breaking of the mass as it rolls over upon itself, may produce these breccias. It is at least certain that the upper portion of the lava-currents of 1811 and 1819 now consist of angular masses to the depth of many yards. D'Aubuisson has compared the surface of one of the ancient lavas of Auvergne to that of a river suddenly frozen over by the stoppage of immense fragments of drift-ice, a description perfectly applicable to these modern Etnean flows. The thickness of the separate beds of conglomerate or breccia which are seen in the same vertical section, is often extremely different, varying from 3 to nearly 50 feet, as I observed in the hill of Calanna.

Lavas and breccias.—Regarding the volcanic masses intersected by dikes in the Val del Bove, they are mostly made up of graystone lavas that are intermediate between basalt and trachyte, along with some porphyritic lava that resembles trachyte. However, according to Von Buch and G. Rose, it can't strictly be called that because the feldspar is the Labradorite variety. There is a strong similarity in the composition of both ancient and modern lavas of Etna, consisting of feldspar, augite, olivine, and titaniferous iron. The alternating breccias are composed of scoria, sand, and angular blocks of lava. Many of these fragments may have been expelled by volcanic eruptions, landing on the hardened surface of flowing lava currents and being carried a considerable distance. It may also occur that when lava moves very slowly, like the flow of 1819, the angular masses formed from frequent breaks as it rolls over itself can create these breccias. It is at least certain that the upper part of the lava flows from 1811 and 1819 now consists of angular masses reaching depths of several yards. D'Aubuisson compared the surface of one of the ancient lavas of Auvergne to that of a river that has suddenly frozen over due to the blockage of large fragments of ice, a description that perfectly fits these modern Etnean flows. The thickness of the different layers of conglomerate or breccia observed in the same vertical section often varies widely, ranging from 3 to nearly 50 feet, as I noted in the hill of Calanna.

Flood produced by the melting of snow by lava.—It is possible that some of the breccias or conglomerates may be referred to aqueous causes, as great floods occasionally sweep down the flanks of Etna, when eruptions take place in winter, and when the snows are melted by lava. It is true that running water in general exerts no power on Etna, the rain which falls being immediately imbibed by the porous lavas; so that, vast as is the extent of the mountain, it feeds only a few small rivulets, and these, even, are dry throughout the greater portion of the year. The enormous rounded boulders, therefore, of felspar-porphyry and basalt, a line of which can be traced from the sea, from near Giardini, by Mascali, and Zafarana, to the "Val del Bove," would offer a perplexing problem to the geologist, if history had not preserved the memorials of a tremendous flood which happened in this district in the year 1755. It appears that two streams of lava flowed in that 412 year, on the 2d of March, from the highest crater; they were immediately precipitated upon an enormous mass of snow which then covered the whole mountain, and was extremely deep near the summit. The sudden melting of this frozen mass, by a fiery torrent three miles in length, produced a frightful inundation, which devastated the sides of the mountain for eight miles in length, and afterwards covered the lower flanks of Etna, where they were less steep, together with the plains near the sea, with great deposits of sand, scoriæ, and blocks of lava.

Flood caused by melting snow from lava.—It's likely that some of the breccias or conglomerates can be attributed to water-related events, as significant floods sometimes rush down the sides of Etna when eruptions occur in winter, melting the snow with lava. While it's true that running water generally has little effect on Etna because the rain that falls is quickly absorbed by the porous lavas, the mountain only supports a few small streams, and even those are dry for most of the year. Therefore, the enormous rounded boulders of felspar-porphyry and basalt, which can be traced from the sea, from near Giardini, through Mascali and Zafarana, to the "Val del Bove," pose a puzzling question for geologists, unless there are records of a massive flood that occurred in this area in 1755. According to reports, two streams of lava flowed on March 2nd of that year from the highest crater; they quickly fell onto a huge mass of snow that covered the entire mountain and was particularly deep near the summit. The sudden melting of this frozen mass by a fiery torrent three miles long resulted in a devastating flood that ravaged the mountainside for eight miles and then covered the lower, less steep flanks of Etna, as well as the nearby plains by the sea, with substantial deposits of sand, scoria, and lava blocks.

Many absurd stories circulated in Sicily respecting this event; such as that the water was boiling, and that it was vomited from the highest crater; that it was as salt as the sea, and full of marine shells; but these were mere inventions, to which Recupero, although he relates them as tales of the mountaineers, seems to have attached rather too much importance.

Many ridiculous stories spread in Sicily about this event, like that the water was boiling and spewed from the highest crater, that it was as salty as the sea and filled with marine shells; however, these were just fabrications that Recupero, although he mentions them as stories from the locals, seems to have given a bit too much weight to.

Floods of considerable violence have also been produced on Etna by the fall of heavy rains, aided, probably, by the melting of snow. By this cause alone, in 1761, sixty of the inhabitants of Acicatena were killed, and many of their houses swept away.571

Floods of significant intensity have also occurred on Etna due to heavy rains, likely worsened by melting snow. Because of this, in 1761, sixty residents of Acicatena lost their lives, and many of their homes were destroyed.571

Glacier covered by a lava-stream.—A remarkable discovery was made on Etna in 1828 of a great mass of ice, preserved for many years, perhaps for centuries, from melting, by the singular accident of a current of red-hot lava having flowed over it. The following are the facts in attestation of a phenomenon which must at first sight appear of so paradoxical a character. The extraordinary heat experienced in the South of Europe, during the summer and autumn of 1828, caused the supplies of snow and ice which had been preserved in the spring of that year, for the use of Catania and the adjoining parts of Sicily and the island of Malta, to fail entirely. Great distress was consequently felt for want of a commodity regarded in those countries as one of the necessaries of life rather than an article of luxury, and the abundance of which contributes in some of the larger cities to the salubrity of the water and the general health of the community. The magistrates of Catania applied to Signor M. Gemmellaro, in the hope that his local knowledge of Etna might enable him to point out some crevice or natural grotto on the mountain, where drift-snow was still preserved. Nor were they disappointed; for he had long suspected that a small mass of perennial ice at the foot of the highest cone was part of a large and continuous glacier covered by a lava-current. Having procured a large body of workmen, he quarried into this ice, and proved the superposition of the lava for several hundred yards, so as completely to satisfy himself that nothing but the subsequent flowing of the lava over the ice could account for the position of the glacier. Unfortunately for the geologist, the ice was so extremely hard, and the excavation so expensive, that there is no probability of the operations being renewed.

Glacier covered by a lava-stream.—A remarkable discovery was made on Etna in 1828 of a large mass of ice, preserved for many years, possibly for centuries, from melting due to the unusual event of a flow of red-hot lava going over it. Here are the facts supporting a phenomenon that might initially seem quite paradoxical. The intense heat felt in Southern Europe during the summer and autumn of 1828 caused the snow and ice supplies that had been saved in the spring of that year for Catania and nearby areas in Sicily and Malta to completely run out. This led to significant distress due to the lack of what is considered a necessity for life in those regions, rather than a luxury item, and the abundance of which helps improve water quality and overall public health in some larger cities. The authorities in Catania turned to Signor M. Gemmellaro, hoping his local expertise on Etna could help them find a crevice or natural grotto on the mountain where drifting snow might still be found. They were not disappointed; he had long believed that a small body of perennial ice at the base of the highest cone was part of a larger, continuous glacier buried under a lava flow. After bringing in a large crew of workers, he began to dig into this ice and confirmed the lava layer above it extended for several hundred yards, fully convincing him that only the later lava flow over the ice could explain the glacier's position. Unfortunately for the geologist, the ice was incredibly hard and the excavation was too costly, making it unlikely that the work would continue.

On the first of December, 1828, I visited this spot, which is on the 413 southeast side of the cone, and not far above the Casa Inglese; but the fresh snow had already nearly filled up the new opening, so that it had only the appearance of the mouth of a grotto. I do not, however, question the accuracy of the conclusion of Signer Gemmellaro, who, being well acquainted with all the appearances of drift-snow in the fissures and cavities of Etna, had recognized, even before the late excavations, the peculiarity of the position of the ice in this locality. We may suppose that, at the commencement of the eruption, a deep mass of drift-snow had been covered by volcanic sand showered down upon it before the descent of the lava. A dense stratum of this fine dust mixed with scoriæ is well known to be an extremely bad conductor of heat; and the shepherds in the higher regions of Etna are accustomed to provide water for their flocks during summer, by strewing a layer of volcanic sand a few inches thick over the snow, which effectually prevents the heat of the sun from penetrating.

On December 1, 1828, I visited this spot, located on the 413 southeast side of the cone, just above the Casa Inglese; however, the fresh snow had nearly filled the new opening, making it look like the entrance of a cave. I don't doubt Signer Gemmellaro's conclusion, who, being very familiar with the features of drift-snow in the cracks and hollows of Etna, recognized, even before the recent excavations, the unique position of the ice in this area. We can assume that at the start of the eruption, a thick layer of drift-snow was covered by volcanic sand that fell on it before the lava flowed down. It's well known that a dense layer of this fine dust mixed with scoria is an extremely poor conductor of heat; and the shepherds in the higher regions of Etna usually ensure water for their sheep in the summer by spreading a few inches of volcanic sand over the snow, which effectively keeps the sun's heat from reaching it.

Suppose the mass of snow to have been preserved from liquefaction until the lower part of the lava had consolidated, we may then readily conceive that a glacier thus protected, at the height of ten thousand feet above the level of the sea, would endure as long as the snows of Mont Blanc, unless melted by volcanic heat from below. When I visited the great crater in the beginning of winter (December 1st, 1828), I found the crevices in the interior incrusted with thick ice, and in some cases hot vapors were actually streaming out between masses of ice and the rugged and steep walls of the crater.572

Suppose the snow had been kept from melting until the lower part of the lava had solidified. We can easily imagine that a glacier, protected like this at an elevation of ten thousand feet above sea level, would last as long as the snow on Mont Blanc, unless it was melted by volcanic heat from below. When I visited the huge crater at the start of winter (December 1st, 1828), I found the cracks inside covered in thick ice, and in some spots, hot vapors were actually pouring out between the blocks of ice and the jagged, steep walls of the crater.572

After the discovery of Signor Gemmellaro, it would not be surprising to find in the cones of the Icelandic volcanoes, which are covered for the most part with perpetual snow, repeated alternations of lava-streams and glaciers. We have, indeed, Lieutenant Kendall's authority for the fact that Deception Island, in New South Shetland, lat. 62° 55' S., is principally composed of alternate layers of volcanic ashes and ice.573

After Signor Gemmellaro's discovery, it wouldn’t be surprising to see layers of lava and glaciers in the cones of the Icelandic volcanoes, which are mostly covered in permanent snow. In fact, we have Lieutenant Kendall's report confirming that Deception Island, located in the New South Shetland at lat. 62° 55' S., is mainly made up of alternating layers of volcanic ash and ice.573

Origin of the Val del Bove.—It is recorded, as will be stated in the history of earthquakes (ch. 29), that in the year 1772 a great subsidence took place on Papandayang, the largest volcano in the island of Java; an extent of ground fifteen miles in length, and six in breadth, covered by no less than forty villages, was engulphed, and the cone lost 4000 feet of its height. In like manner the summit of Carguairazo, one of the loftiest of the Andes of Quito, fell in on the 19th July, 1698; and another mountain of still greater altitude in the same chain, called Capac Urcu, a short time before the conquest of America by the Spaniards.

Origin of the Val del Bove.—It is recorded, as will be stated in the history of earthquakes (ch. 29), that in 1772 a significant collapse occurred on Papandayang, the largest volcano on the island of Java; an area fifteen miles long and six miles wide, which was home to no fewer than forty villages, was engulfed, and the cone lost 4,000 feet of its height. Similarly, the summit of Carguairazo, one of the highest peaks in the Andes of Quito, collapsed on July 19, 1698; and another mountain of even greater height in the same range, called Capac Urcu, experienced a similar fate shortly before the Spaniards conquered America.

414 It will also be seen in the next chapter that, so late as the year 1822, during a violent earthquake and volcanic eruption in Java, one side of the mountain called Galongoon, which was covered by a dense forest, became an enormous gulf in the form of a semicircle. The new cavity was about midway between the summit and the plain, and surrounded by steep rocks.

414 In the next chapter, it will also be noted that as late as 1822, during a severe earthquake and volcanic eruption in Java, one side of the mountain known as Galongoon, which was covered in thick forest, turned into a massive semicircular gulf. This new cavity was roughly halfway between the peak and the flatlands and was surrounded by steep cliffs.

Now we might imagine a similar event, or a series of subsidences to have formerly occurred on the eastern side of Etna, although such catastrophes have not been witnessed in modern times, or only on a very trifling scale. A narrow ravine, about a mile long, twenty feet wide, and from twenty to thirty-six in depth, has been formed, within the historical era, on the flanks of the volcano, near the town of Mascalucia; and a small circular tract, called the Cisterna, near the summit, sank down in the year 1792, to the depth of about forty feet, and left on all sides of the chasm a vertical section of the beds, exactly resembling those which are seen in the precipices of the Val del Bove. At some remote periods, therefore, we might suppose more extensive portions of the mountain to have fallen in during great earthquakes.

Now we might imagine that a similar event, or a series of collapses, previously occurred on the eastern side of Etna, although such disasters haven't been seen in modern times, or only on a very small scale. A narrow ravine, about a mile long, twenty feet wide, and between twenty and thirty-six feet deep, has formed, within recorded history, on the flanks of the volcano, near the town of Mascalucia; and a small circular area, known as the Cisterna, near the summit, sank down in 1792, to a depth of about forty feet, creating a vertical section of the layers, similar to those found in the cliffs of the Val del Bove. Therefore, we might assume that larger sections of the mountain could have collapsed during significant earthquakes in the distant past.

But we ought not to exclude entirely from our speculations another possible agency, by which the great cavity may in part at least have been excavated, namely, the denuding action of the sea. Whether its waves may once have had access to the great valley before the ancient portion of Etna was upheaved to its present elevation, is a question which will naturally present itself to every geologist. Marine shells have been traced to a height of 800 feet above the base of Etna, and would doubtless be seen to ascend much higher, were not the structure of the lower region of the mountain concealed by floods of lava. We cannot ascertain to what extent a change in the relative level of land and sea may have been carried in this spot, but we know that some of the tertiary strata in Sicily of no ancient date reach a height of 3000 feet, and the marine deposits on the flanks of Etna, full of recent species of shells, may ascend to equal or greater heights. The narrow Valley of Calanna leading out of the Val del Bove, and that of San Giacomo lower down, have much the appearance of ravines swept out by aqueous action.

But we shouldn't completely rule out another possible factor that could have helped shape the large cavity, which is the erosion caused by the sea. Whether its waves ever reached the vast valley before the ancient part of Etna was lifted to its current height is a question that every geologist would naturally consider. Marine shells have been found at an altitude of 800 feet above the base of Etna, and they would likely be found even higher if the lower part of the mountain wasn't hidden by lava flows. We can't determine the extent of any changes in the land and sea level in this area, but we know that some of the tertiary layers in Sicily are relatively young and reach up to 3000 feet in height. The marine deposits on Etna's slopes, which are filled with recent shell species, may also rise to equal or greater elevations. The narrow Valley of Calanna, which leads out of the Val del Bove, and the lower San Giacomo Valley both look like ravines that were eroded by water.

Structure and origin of the cone of Etna.—Our data for framing a correct theory of the manner in which the cone of Etna has acquired its present dimensions and internal structure are very imperfect, because it is on its eastern side only, in the Val del Bove above described, that we see a deep section exposed. Even here we obtain no insight into the interior composition of the mountain beyond a depth of between three and four thousand feet below the base of that highest cone, which has been several times destroyed and renewed. The precipices seen at the head of the Val del Bove, in the escarpment called the Serre del Solfizio, exhibit merely the same series of alternating lavas and breccias, which, descending with a general dip towards the sea, form the boundary cliffs of all other parts of the Val del Bove. If then we estimate 415 the height of Etna at about 11,000 feet, we may say that we know from actual observation less than one-half of its component materials, assuming it to extend downwards to the level of the sea; namely, first, the highest cone, which is about 1000 feet above its base; and, secondly, the alternations of lava, tuff, and volcanic breccia, which constitute the rocks between the Cisterna, near the base of the upper cone, and the foot of the precipices at the head of the Val del Bove. At the lowest point to which the vertical section extends, there are no signs of any approach to a termination of the purely volcanic mass, which may perhaps penetrate many thousand feet farther downwards. There is, indeed, a rock called Rocca Gianicola, near the foot of the great escarpment, which consists of a large mass between 150 and 200 feet wide, not divided into beds, and almost resembling granite in its structure, although agreeing very closely in mineral composition with the lavas of Etna in general.574 This mass may doubtless be taken as a representative of those crystalline or plutonic formations which would be met with in abundance if we could descend to greater depths in the direction of the central axis of the mountain. For a great body of geological evidence leads us to conclude, that rocks of this class result from the consolidation, under great pressure, of melted matter, which has risen up and filled rents and chasms, such, for example, as may communicate with the principal and minor vents of eruption in a volcano like Etna.

Structure and origin of the cone of Etna.—Our information for developing an accurate theory about how the cone of Etna reached its current size and internal structure is quite limited. This is mainly because we can only see a deep section exposed on its eastern side, in the Val del Bove as previously discussed. Even here, we gain little understanding of the mountain's internal composition beyond a depth of approximately three to four thousand feet beneath the base of the highest cone, which has been destroyed and rebuilt several times. The cliffs at the head of the Val del Bove, in the escarpment known as the Serre del Solfizio, show only the same series of alternating lava flows and breccias, which, sloping generally towards the sea, form the border cliffs of other areas in the Val del Bove. If we estimate the height of Etna at about 11,000 feet, we can say that we know from direct observation less than half of its constituent materials, assuming it continues down to sea level; specifically, the highest cone, which is about 1,000 feet above its base, and the layers of lava, tuff, and volcanic breccia that make up the rocks between the Cisterna, near the base of the upper cone, and the foot of the cliffs at the head of the Val del Bove. At the lowest point that the vertical section reaches, there are no indications of an endpoint to the purely volcanic mass, which may extend many thousands of feet deeper. There is a rock called Rocca Gianicola, near the base of the large escarpment, composed of a large mass between 150 and 200 feet wide, not layered, and resembling granite in structure, although closely matching the mineral composition of Etna's lavas. This mass may likely represent the crystalline or plutonic formations that would be found in abundance if we could dive deeper along the mountain's central axis. Geological evidence strongly suggests that such rocks form from the consolidation, under considerable pressure, of molten material that has risen to fill cracks and voids, possibly connected to the main and minor eruption vents in a volcano like Etna.

But, if we speculate on the nature of the formation which the lava may have pierced in its way upwards, we may fairly presume that a portion of these consist of marine tertiary rocks, like those of the neighboring Val di Noto, or those which skirt the borders of the Etnean cone, on its southern and eastern sides. Etna may, in fact, have been at first an insular volcano, raising its summit but slightly above the level of the sea; but we have no grounds for concluding that any of the beds exposed in the deep section of the Val del Bove have formed a part of such a marine accumulation. On the contrary, all the usual signs of subaqueous origin are wanting; and even if we believe the foundations of the mountain to have been laid in the sea, we could not expect this portion to be made visible in sections which only proceed downwards from the summit through one-half the thickness of the mountain, especially as the highest points attained by the tertiary strata in other parts of Sicily very rarely exceed 3000 feet above the sea.

But if we think about the type of layers that the lava might have broken through on its way up, we can reasonably assume that some of these include marine tertiary rocks, similar to those found in the nearby Val di Noto, or those that line the southern and eastern sides of the Etna cone. Etna may have originally been an island volcano, with its peak barely above sea level; however, we have no evidence to suggest that any of the layers visible in the deep section of the Val del Bove were part of such a marine formation. On the contrary, all the typical indicators of underwater origins are absent; and even if we assume that the foundations of the mountain were formed in the sea, we wouldn't expect to see this part visible in sections that only extend downward from the summit through half the thickness of the mountain, especially since the highest elevations of the tertiary layers in other parts of Sicily rarely exceed 3000 feet above sea level.

On the eastern and southern base of Etna, a marine deposit, already alluded to, is traced up to the height of 800 or 1000 feet, before it becomes concealed beneath that covering of modern lavas which is continually extending its limits during successive eruptions, and prevents us from ascertaining how much higher the marine strata may ascend. As the imbedded shells belong almost entirely to species now inhabiting the Mediterranean, it is evident that there has been here an upheaval of the region at the base of Etna at a very modern period. It is fair, therefore, 416 to infer that the volcanic nucleus of the mountain, partly perhaps of submarine, and partly of subaerial origin, participated in this movement, and was carried up bodily. Now, in proportion as a cone gains height by such a movement, combined with the cumulative effects of eruptions, throwing out matter successively from one or more central vents, the hydrostatic pressure of the columns of lava augments with their increasing height, until the time arrives when the flanks of the cone can no longer resist the increased pressure; and from that period they give way more readily, lateral outbursts becoming more frequent. Hence, independently of any local expansion of the fractured volcanic mass, those general causes by which the modern tertiary strata of a great part of Sicily have been raised to the height of several thousand feet above their original level, would tend naturally to render the discharge of lava and scoriæ from the summit of Etna less copious, and the lateral discharge greater.

On the eastern and southern sides of Etna, there's a marine deposit that extends up to 800 or 1000 feet high before it gets hidden under the layer of modern lavas, which keeps expanding with each eruption and prevents us from knowing how much higher the marine layers might go. Since the embedded shells mostly belong to species currently found in the Mediterranean, it’s clear that there has been a significant uplifting of the area at the base of Etna in relatively recent times. Therefore, it’s reasonable to assume that the volcanic core of the mountain, partly formed underwater and partly from above ground, was lifted as well. As the cone gains height through this process, combined with the building effects of eruptions that eject material from one or more central vents, the hydrostatic pressure of the lava columns increases with height, until the sides of the cone can no longer withstand this pressure. At that point, they start to give way more easily, leading to more frequent lateral eruptions. Thus, apart from any local expansion of the broken volcanic mass, the various factors that have raised much of the modern tertiary layers of Sicily to several thousand feet above their original level would likely cause a decrease in the lava and ash being discharged from the summit of Etna while increasing the lateral eruptions.

If, then, a conical or dome-shaped mass of volcanic materials was accumulated to the height of 4000, or perhaps 7000 feet, before the upward movement began, or, what is much more probable, during the continuance of the upward movement, that ancient mass would not be buried under the products of newer eruptions, because these last would then be poured out chiefly at a lower level.

If a cone or dome-shaped pile of volcanic material built up to a height of 4,000 or maybe 7,000 feet before the upward movement started, or, which is more likely, while the upward movement was still happening, that old pile wouldn't end up buried under the materials from newer eruptions, because those would mainly come out at a lower level.

Since I visited Etna in 1828, M. de Beaumont has published a most valuable memoir on the structure and origin of that mountain, which he examined in 1834;575 and an excellent description of it has also appeared in the posthumous work of Hoffmann.576

Since I visited Etna in 1828, M. de Beaumont has published a very useful paper on the structure and origin of that mountain, which he studied in 1834;575 and a great description of it has also appeared in the posthumous work of Hoffmann.576

In M. de Beaumont's essay, in which he has explained his views with uncommon perspicuity and talent, he maintains that all the alternating stony and fragmentary beds, more than 3000 feet thick, which are exposed in the Val del Bove, were formed originally on a surface so nearly flat that the slope never exceeded three degrees. From this horizontal position they were at length heaved up suddenly (d'un seul coup) into a great mountain, to which no important additions have since been made. Prior to this upthrow, a platform is supposed to have existed above the level of the sea, in which various fissures opened; and from these melted matter was poured forth again and again, which spread itself around in thin sheets of uniform thickness. From the same rents issued showers of scoriæ and fragmentary matter, which were spread out so as to form equally uniform and horizontal beds, intervening between the sheets of lava. But although, by the continued repetition of these operations, a vast pile of volcanic matter, 4000 feet or more in thickness, was built up precisely in that region where Etna now rises, and to which nothing similar was produced elsewhere in Sicily, still we are told that Etna was not yet a mountain. No hypothetical diagram has been given to help us to conceive how this great mass of materials of supramarine origin 417 could have been disposed of in horizontal beds, so as not to constitute an eminence towering far above the rest of Sicily; but it is assumed that a powerful force from below at length burst suddenly through the horizontal formation, uplifted it to a considerable height, and caused the beds to be, in many places, highly inclined. This elevatory force was not all expended on a single central point as Von Buch has imagined in the case of Palma, Teneriffe, or Somma, but rather followed for a short distance a linear direction.577

In M. de Beaumont's essay, where he clearly and skillfully explains his views, he argues that all the alternating rocky and fragmented layers, over 3000 feet thick, visible in the Val del Bove, were originally formed on a surface that was almost flat, with a slope that never exceeded three degrees. Eventually, this horizontal layer was suddenly lifted up into a massive mountain, which hasn't seen any significant additions since. Before this upheaval, there was likely a platform above sea level with various cracks, from which molten material was repeatedly released, spreading out in thin, uniform layers. From these same cracks, showers of volcanic ash and fragmented material emerged, creating equally uniform and flat layers between the sheets of lava. However, despite the continuous cycle of these processes resulting in a massive buildup of volcanic material, over 4000 feet thick, exactly where Mount Etna currently stands—an area that produced nothing similar anywhere else in Sicily—it’s noted that Etna wasn't yet a mountain. No illustrative diagram has been provided to help us visualize how this substantial mass of material from above sea level could be arranged in horizontal layers without forming a peak significantly taller than the rest of Sicily; it’s assumed that a strong force from below eventually burst through this horizontal structure, raising it to a considerable height and causing the layers to tilt in many areas. This lifting force did not focus on a single central point as Von Buch suggested for Palma, Tenerife, or Somma, but rather followed a linear path for a short distance.

Among other objections that may be advanced against the theory above proposed, I may mention, first, that the increasing number of dikes as we approach the head of the Val del Bove, or the middle of Etna, and the great thickness of lava, scoriæ, and conglomerates in that region, imply that the great centre of eruption was always where it now is, or nearly at the same point, and there must, therefore, have been a tendency, from the beginning, to a conical or dome-shaped arrangement in the ejected materials. Secondly, were we to admit a great number of separate points of eruption, scattered over a plain or platform, there must have been a great number of cones thrown up over these different vents; and these hills, some of which would probably be as lofty as those now seen on the flanks of Etna, or from 300 to 750 feet in height, would break the continuity of the sheets of lava, while they would become gradually enveloped by them. The ejected materials, moreover, would slope at a high angle on the sides of these cones, and where they fell on the surrounding plain, would form strata thicker near the base of each cone than at a distance.

Among other objections that could be raised against the theory mentioned above, I should point out, first, that the increasing number of dikes as we get closer to the head of the Val del Bove, or the middle of Etna, along with the significant thickness of lava, scoria, and conglomerates in that area, suggests that the main eruption center has always been where it is now, or very close to it. Therefore, there must have been a tendency from the start for the ejected materials to arrange themselves in a conical or dome-shaped formation. Secondly, if we were to accept the idea of multiple separate eruption points spread across a flat area, there would need to be a large number of cones created over these different vents; and these hills, some of which could be as tall as those currently seen on the slopes of Etna, ranging from 300 to 750 feet high, would disrupt the flow of the lava sheets while gradually being covered by them. Additionally, the ejected materials would slope steeply on the sides of these cones, and where they settled on the surrounding plain, they'd create layers thicker near the base of each cone than further away.

What then are the facts, it will be asked, to account for which this hypothesis of original horizontality, followed by a single and sudden effort of upheaval, which gave to the beds their present slope, has been invented? M. de Beaumont observes, that in the boundary precipices of the Val del Bove, sheets of lava and intercalated beds of cinders, mixed with pulverulent and fragmentary matter evidently cast out during eruptions, are sometimes inclined at steep angles, varying from 15° to 27°. It is impossible, he says, that the lavas could have flowed originally on planes so steeply inclined, for streams which descend a slope even of 10° form narrow stripes, and never acquire such a compact texture. Their thickness, moreover, always inconsiderable, varies with every variation of steepness, in the declivity down which they flow; whereas, in several parts of the Val del Bove, the sheets of lava are continuous for great distances, in spite of their steep inclination, and are often compact, and perfectly parallel one to the other, even where there are more than 100 beds of interpolated fragmentary matter.

What are the facts that lead to the creation of this hypothesis of original horizontality, followed by a single, sudden event of uplift that gave the layers their current slope? M. de Beaumont notes that in the steep cliffs of the Val del Bove, layers of lava and interspersed beds of cinders, mixed with fine and fragmented material clearly ejected during eruptions, are sometimes tilted at steep angles ranging from 15° to 27°. He argues that it's impossible for the lavas to have initially flowed on such steep slopes, as streams moving down even a 10° incline create narrow paths and never achieve such a solid texture. Additionally, their thickness, which is generally small, changes with any variations in the steepness of the slope they descend; however, in several areas of the Val del Bove, the sheets of lava extend for considerable distances despite their steep angles and are often solid and perfectly parallel to one another, even when there are more than 100 layers of interspersed fragmented material.

The intersecting dikes also terminate upwards in many instances, at different elevations, and blend (or, as M. de Beaumont terms it, articulate) with sheets of lava, which they meet at right angles. It is therefore assumed that such dikes were the feeders of the streams of lava 418 with which they unite, and they are supposed to prove that the platform, on the surface of which the melted matter was poured out, was at first so flat, that the fluid mass spread freely and equally in every direction, and not towards one point only of the compass, as would happen if it had descended the sloping sides of a cone. This argument is ingeniously and plainly put in the following terms:—"Had the melted matter poured down an inclined plane, after issuing from a rent, the sheet of lava would, after consolidation, have formed an elbow with the dike, like the upper bar of the letter F, instead of extending itself on both sides like that of a T."578 It is also contended that a series of sheets of lava, formed on a conical or dome-shaped mountain, would have been more numerous at points farthest from the central axis, since every dike which had been the source of a lava-stream, must have poured its contents downwards, and never upwards.

The intersecting dikes often end at different heights and connect with sheets of lava at right angles. It's assumed that these dikes were the sources of the lava flows they join, suggesting that the surface where the molten material erupted was initially so flat that the liquid spread out equally in all directions, rather than just one direction like it would if it had come down the sloped sides of a cone. This argument is clearly and cleverly stated as follows: “If the molten material had flowed down an inclined plane after coming from a crack, the lava sheet would have formed a bend with the dike, similar to the top bar of the letter F, instead of extending out equally on both sides like a T.” It’s also argued that a series of lava sheets formed on a conical or dome-shaped mountain would be more frequent at points farther from the center, as every dike that fed a lava flow must have sent its material downwards, never upwards. 418

Fig. 54.

Fig. 54.

Dikes as they would now appear had they been originally perpendicular.

Dikes as they would now appear had they been originally perpendicular.

Dikes would look like they do today if they had been built straight up from the start.

In reference to the facts here stated, I may mention that the dikes which I saw in the Val del Bove were either vertical, or made almost all of them a near approach to the perpendicular, which could not have been the case had they been the feeders of horizontal beds of lava, and had they consequently joined them originally at right angles, for then the dikes, as at a, b, c, fig. 54, ought subsequently to have acquired a considerable slope, like the beds which they intersect. I may also urge another objection to the views above set forth, namely, that had the dikes been linear vents, or orifices of eruption, we must suppose the inter-stratified scoriæ and lapilli, as well as the lavas, to have come out of them, and in that case the irregular heaping up of fragmentary matter around the vents would, as before hinted, have disturbed that uniform thickness and parallelism of the beds which M. de Beaumont describes.

Regarding the facts mentioned here, I should point out that the dikes I observed in the Val del Bove were either vertical or very close to perpendicular. This wouldn't have been the case if they were the feeders of horizontal lava beds and had originally joined them at right angles. In that situation, the dikes, like those at a, b, c, fig. 54, would have had to develop a significant slope, similar to the beds they intersect. I also want to highlight another issue with the views previously presented: if the dikes were linear vents or eruption openings, we would need to assume that the inter-stratified scoria and lapilli, as well as the lavas, originated from them. In that case, the uneven accumulation of fragmented material around the vents would have disrupted the uniform thickness and parallelism of the beds that M. de Beaumont describes.

If, however, some of the sheets of lava join the dikes in such a manner, as to imply that they were in a melted state simultaneously with the contents of the fissures,—a point not easily ascertained, where the 419 precipices are for the most part inaccessible,—the fact may admit of a different interpretation from that proposed by the French geologists. Rents like those before alluded to (p. 399), which opened in the plain of S. Lio in 1669, filled below with incandescent lava, may have lain in the way of currents of melted matter descending from higher openings. In that case, the matter of the current would have flowed into the fissure and mixed with the lava at its bottom. Numerous open rents of this kind are described by Mr. Dana as having been caused, during a late eruption, in one of the volcanic domes of the Sandwich Islands. They remained open at various heights on the slopes of the great cone, running in different directions, and demonstrate the possibility of future junctions of slightly inclined lava-streams with perpendicular walls of lava.

If some of the lava sheets connect with the dikes in a way that suggests they were molten at the same time as the fissures—something that's hard to determine since the 419 cliffs are mostly hard to reach—this could mean something different than what the French geologists proposed. Cracks like the ones mentioned earlier (p. 399), which opened up in the S. Lio plain in 1669 and were filled at the bottom with glowing lava, might have obstructed flows of molten material coming down from higher openings. In that case, the molten material would have flowed into the fissure and mixed with the lava at the base. Mr. Dana describes numerous open cracks created during a recent eruption in one of the volcanic domes of the Sandwich Islands. These remained open at various heights on the slopes of the large cone, running in different directions, and show that future connections of slightly sloped lava streams with vertical lava walls are possible.

To me, therefore, it appears far more easy to explain the uniform thickness and parallelism of so many lavas and beds of fragmentary matter seen in the Val del Bove, by supposing them to have issued successively out of one or more higher vents near the summit of a great dome, than to imagine them to have proceeded from lateral dikes or rents opening in a level plain. In the Sandwich Islands, we have examples of volcanic domes 15,000 feet high, produced by successive outpourings from vents at or near the summit. One of these, Mount Loa, has a slope in all directions of 6° 30'; another, Mount Kea, a mean inclination of 7° 46'. That their lavas may occasionally consolidate on slopes of 25°, and even more, and still preserve considerable solidity of texture, has been already stated; see above, p. 383.

To me, it seems much easier to explain the consistent thickness and parallel layers of various lavas and fragmented materials observed in the Val del Bove by suggesting they gradually flowed out from one or more higher vents near the top of a large dome, instead of imagining they originated from side dikes or cracks opening in a flat area. In the Sandwich Islands, we see examples of volcanic domes that rise 15,000 feet, formed by successive eruptions from vents at or close to the summit. One of these, Mount Loa, has a slope of 6° 30° in all directions; another, Mount Kea, has an average slope of 7° 46°. It's already been noted that their lavas can sometimes solidify on slopes of 25° or even steeper while still maintaining significant structural strength; see above, p. 383.

We know not how large a quantity of modern lava may have been poured into the bottom of the Val del Bove, yet we perceive that eruptions breaking forth near the centre of Etna have already made some progress in filling up this great hollow. Even within the memory of persons now living, the rocks of Musara and Capra have, as before stated, lost much of their height and picturesque grandeur by the piling up of recent lavas round their base (see fig. 51, p. 408), and the great chasm has intercepted many streams which would otherwise have deluged the fertile region below, as has happened on the side of Catania. The volcanic forces are now laboring, therefore, to repair the breach which subsidence has caused on one side of the great cone; and unless their energy should decline, or a new sinking take place, they may in time efface this inequality. In that event, the restored portion will always be unconformable to the more ancient part, yet it will consist, like it, of alternating beds of lava, scoriæ;, and conglomerates, which, with all their irregularities, will have a general slope from the centre and summit of Etna towards the sea.

We don't know how much modern lava has been poured into the bottom of the Val del Bove, but we can see that eruptions coming from the center of Etna have already made some progress in filling this large depression. Even within the memories of people alive today, the rocks of Musara and Capra have, as previously stated, lost much of their height and scenic beauty due to the accumulation of recent lavas around their bases (see fig. 51, p. 408), and the large chasm has blocked many streams that would have otherwise flooded the fertile area below, as it has on the side of Catania. The volcanic forces are currently working to repair the damage caused by collapse on one side of the great cone; unless their activity decreases or another collapse occurs, they may eventually level this unevenness. In that case, the restored area will always be distinct from the older part, but it will consist, like the older part, of alternating layers of lava, scoria, and conglomerates, which, despite their irregularities, will generally slope from the center and peak of Etna toward the sea.

I shall conclude, then, by remarking that I conceive the general inclination of the alternating stony and fragmentary beds of the Val del Bove, from the axis of Etna towards its circumference or base, and the greater thickness of the volcanic pile as we approach the central parts of the mountain, to be due to the preponderance of eruptions from that centre. These gave rise, from the first, to a dome-shaped mass, which 420 has ever since been increasing in height and area, being fractured again and again by the expansive force of vapors, and the several parts made to cohere together more firmly after the solidification of the lava with which every open fissure and chasm has been filled. At the same time the cone may have gained a portion of its height by the elevatory effect of such dislocating movements, and the sheets of lava may have acquired in some places a greater, in others a less, inclination than that which at first belonged to them.

I will wrap up by saying that I believe the general slope of the alternating rocky and fragmented layers of the Val del Bove, from the center of Etna to its base, and the thicker volcanic buildup as we get closer to the middle of the mountain, result from the dominance of eruptions from that central area. These initially formed a dome-shaped mass, which 420 has since been growing in height and size, repeatedly fractured by the expanding force of gases, while the various parts have come together more tightly after the lava filling every open crack and gap solidified. At the same time, the cone may have gained some of its height due to the uplifting nature of these dislocating movements, and the layers of lava may have taken on a greater slope in some spots and a lesser slope in others than what they originally had.

Fig. 55.Non-volcanic protuberance and valley of elevation.

Non-volcanic protuberance and valley of elevation.

Non-volcanic hill and elevated valley.

But had the mountain been due solely, or even principally, to upheaval, its structure would have resembled that which geologists have so often recognized in dome-shaped hills, or certain elevated regions, which all consider as having been thrust up by a force from below. In this case there is often an elliptical cavity at the summit, due partly to the fracture of the upraised rocks, but still more to aqueous denudation, as they rose out of the sea. The central cavity, or valley, exposes to view the subjacent formation c, fig. 55, and the incumbent mass dips away on all sides from the axis, but has no tendency to thin out near the base of the dome, or at x, x; whereas at this point the volcanic mass terminates (see fig. 56) and allows the fundamental rock c to appear at the surface. In the last diagram, the more ordinary case is represented of a great hollow or crater at the summit of the volcanic cone; but instead of this, we have seen that in the case of Etna there is a deep lateral depression, called the Val del Bove, the upper part of which approaches near to the central axis, and the origin of which we have attributed to subsidence.

But if the mountain had formed solely, or even mainly, from upheaval, its structure would look like what geologists often see in dome-shaped hills or certain elevated areas that everyone agrees were pushed up by a force from below. In this case, there's usually an elliptical cavity at the top, partly due to the breaking of the uplifted rocks, but even more because of water erosion as they came out of the sea. The central cavity or valley reveals the underlying layer c, fig. 55, and the rock mass above slopes down on all sides from the center, without thinning out near the base of the dome, or at x, x; however, at this point, the volcanic material ends (see fig. 56) and lets the base rock c show at the surface. In the last diagram, the more typical scenario is shown of a large hollow or crater at the peak of the volcanic cone; but instead, we’ve seen that in the case of Etna, there’s a deep side depression called the Val del Bove, the upper part of which gets close to the central axis, and we believe its origin is due to subsidence.

Fig. 56.Volcanic mountain and crater.

Volcanic mountain and crater.

Volcanic mountain and caldera.

Antiquity of the cone of Etna.—It was before remarked that confined notions in regard to the quantity of past time have tended, more than any other prepossessions, to retard the progress of sound theoretical views in geology;579 the inadequacy of our conceptions of the earth's antiquity having cramped the freedom of our speculations in this science, very much in the same way as a belief in the existence of a vaulted firmament once retarded the progress of astronomy. It was not until Descartes assumed the indefinite extent of the celestial spaces, and removed the supposed boundaries of the universe, that just opinions began 421 to be entertained of the relative distances of the heavenly bodies; and until we habituate ourselves to contemplate the possibility of an indefinite lapse of ages having been comprised within each of the modern periods of the earth's history, we shall be in danger of forming most erroneous and partial views in geology.

Antiquity of the cone of Etna.—It's been noted before that narrow views about how much time has passed have held back the development of solid theories in geology; 579 our limited understanding of the earth's age has restricted our ability to think freely in this field, much like the belief in a solid sky once hindered the advancement of astronomy. It wasn't until Descartes proposed the infinite expanse of space and eliminated the imagined limits of the universe that more accurate ideas about the distances between celestial bodies began to emerge; and until we get used to considering the possibility of an endless span of time existing within each of the modern chapters of the earth's history, we risk creating very mistaken and incomplete perspectives in geology.

If history had bequeathed to us a faithful record of the eruptions of Etna, and a hundred other of the principal active volcanoes of the globe, during the last three thousand years,—if we had an exact account of the volume of lava and matter ejected during that period, and the times of their production,—we might, perhaps, be able to form a correct estimate of the average rate of the growth of a volcanic cone. For we might obtain a mean result from the comparison of the eruptions of so great a number of vents, however irregular might be the development of the igneous action in any one of them, if contemplated singly during a brief period.

If history had given us a reliable record of the eruptions of Etna and a hundred other major active volcanoes around the world over the last three thousand years—if we had a detailed account of the volume of lava and material ejected during that time, along with the timing of each eruption—we might be able to accurately estimate the average rate of growth of a volcanic cone. By comparing the eruptions of such a large number of vents, we could arrive at a meaningful result, even if the volcanic activity in each individual vent varied widely when looked at during a short time frame.

It would be necessary to balance protracted periods of inaction against the occasional outburst of paroxysmal explosions. Sometimes we should have evidence of a repose of seventeen centuries, like that which was interposed in Ischia, between the end of the fourth century B. C., and the beginning of the fourteenth century of our era.580 Occasionally a tremendous eruption, like that of Jorullo, would be recorded, giving rise, at once, to a considerable mountain.

It would be necessary to balance long periods of inactivity with occasional bursts of chaotic explosions. Sometimes we should see evidence of a rest lasting seventeen centuries, like the one that occurred in Ischia, between the end of the fourth century BCE and the beginning of the fourteenth century A.D.580 Occasionally, a massive eruption, like that of Jorullo, would be noted, immediately resulting in a significant mountain.

If we desire to approximate to the age of a cone such as Etna, we ought first to obtain some data in regard to the thickness of matter which has been added during the historical era, and then endeavor to estimate the time required for the accumulation of such alternating lavas and beds of sand and scoriæ as are superimposed upon each other in the Val del Bove; afterwards we should try to deduce, from observations on other volcanoes, the more or less rapid increase of burning mountains in all the different stages of their growth.

If we want to estimate the age of a cone like Mount Etna, we should first gather information about how much material has built up during historical times. Then, we need to try to estimate how long it took for all the layers of lava, sand, and cinders that are piled up in the Val del Bove to accumulate. After that, we should look at observations from other volcanoes to figure out how quickly different types of active volcanoes grow through various stages.

There is a considerable analogy between the mode of increase of a volcanic cone and that of trees of exogenous growth. These trees augment, both in height and diameter, by the successive application externally of cone upon cone of new ligneous matter; so that if we make a transverse section near the base of the trunk, we intersect a much greater number of layers than nearer to the summit. When branches occasionally shoot out from the trunk, they first pierce the bark, and then, after growing to a certain size, if they chance to be broken off, they may become inclosed in the body of the tree, as it augments in size, forming knots in the wood, which are themselves composed of layers of ligneous matter, cone within cone.

There is a significant similarity between how a volcanic cone grows and how trees with exogenous growth increase in size. These trees get taller and wider by adding new layers of wood to the outside, just like a cone grows by layering more material. So, if we cut a cross-section near the base of the trunk, we find a lot more layers than if we cut near the top. When branches sometimes sprout from the trunk, they first break through the bark, and then, if they grow to a certain size and happen to break off, they can become enclosed in the tree as it grows larger, creating knots in the wood, which consist of layers of wood, one inside another.

In like manner, a volcanic mountain, as we have seen, consists of a succession of conical masses enveloping others, while lateral cones, having a similar internal structure, often project, in the first instance, like branches from the surface of the main cone, and then becoming buried again, are hidden like the knots of a tree.

In the same way, a volcanic mountain, as we've seen, is made up of a series of cone-shaped mounds surrounding others, while side cones, which have a similar internal structure, often stick out at first like branches from the main cone's surface, and then, once again buried, are hidden like the knots of a tree.

422 We can ascertain the age of an oak or pine by counting the number of concentric rings of annual growth seen in a transverse section near the base, so that we may know the date at which the seedling began to vegetate. The Baobab-tree of Senegal (Adansonia digitata) is supposed to exceed almost any other in longevity. Adanson inferred that one which he measured, and found to be thirty feet in diameter, had attained the age of 5150 years. Having made an incision to a certain depth, he first counted three hundred rings of annual growth, and observed what thickness the tree had gained in that period. The average rate of growth of younger trees, of the same species, was then ascertained, and the calculation made according to a supposed mean rate of increase. De Candolle considers it not improbable that the celebrated Taxodium of Chapultepec, in Mexico (Cupressus disticha, Linn.), which is 117 feet in circumference, may be still more aged.581

422 We can determine the age of an oak or pine by counting the number of concentric rings of annual growth visible in a cross-section near the base, allowing us to know when the seedling started to grow. The Baobab tree of Senegal (Adansonia digitata) is believed to be one of the longest-living trees. Adanson estimated that one he measured, which had a diameter of thirty feet, was 5,150 years old. After making a cut to a certain depth, he first counted three hundred rings of annual growth and noted how much thickness the tree had gained during that time. The average growth rate of younger trees of the same species was then determined, and the calculation was made based on a presumed average increase rate. De Candolle thinks it’s quite possible that the famous Taxodium of Chapultepec in Mexico (Cupressus disticha, Linn.), which has a circumference of 117 feet, may be even older.581

It is, however, impossible, until more data are collected respecting the average intensity of the volcanic action, to make any thing like an approximation to the age of a cone like Etna; because, in this case, the successive envelopes of lava and scoriæ are not continuous, like the layers of wood in a tree, and afford us no definite measure of time. Each conical envelope is made up of a great number of distinct lava-currents and showers of sand and scoriæ, differing in quantity, and which may have been accumulated in unequal periods of time. Yet we cannot fail to form the most exalted conception of the antiquity of this mountain, when we consider that its base is about ninety miles in circumference; so that it would require ninety flows of lava, each a mile in breadth at their termination, to raise the present foot of the volcano as much as the average height of one lava-current.

It is, however, impossible to make any real estimate of the age of a cone like Etna until more data is collected regarding the average intensity of volcanic activity. This is because the layers of lava and volcanic debris aren’t continuous like the rings of a tree, and they don’t provide a clear measure of time. Each conical layer consists of numerous distinct lava flows and deposits of sand and volcanic debris, varying in amount, which may have formed over different periods. Yet, we can’t help but have a deep appreciation for the age of this mountain when we consider that its base is about ninety miles around; it would take ninety lava flows, each a mile wide at their ends, to raise the current base of the volcano by the average height of one lava flow.

There are no records within the historical era which lead to the opinion that the altitude of Etna has materially varied within the last two thousand years. Of the eighty most conspicuous minor cones which adorn its flanks, only one of the largest, Monti Rossi, has been produced within the times of authentic history. Even this hill, thrown up in the year 1669, although 450 feet in height, only ranks as a cone of second magnitude. Monte Minardo, near Bronte, rises, even now, to the height of 750 feet, although its base has been elevated by more modern lavas and ejections. The dimensions of these larger cones appear to bear testimony to paroxysms of volcanic activity, after which we may conclude, from analogy, that the fires of Etna remained dormant for many years—since nearly a century of rest has sometimes followed a violent eruption in the historical era. It must also be remembered, that of the small number of eruptions which occur in a century, one only is estimated to issue from the summit of Etna for every two that proceed from the sides. Nor do all the lateral eruptions give rise to such cones as would be reckoned amongst the smallest of the eighty hills above enumerated; some of them produce merely insignificant monticules, which are soon afterwards buried by showers of ashes.

There are no records from the historical period that suggest the height of Etna has significantly changed in the last two thousand years. Of the eighty most prominent minor cones that line its slopes, only one of the largest, Monti Rossi, has formed during documented history. Even this hill, which emerged in 1669 and is 450 feet tall, is classified as a cone of second magnitude. Monte Minardo, located near Bronte, currently rises to 750 feet, although its base has been raised by more recent lava flows and eruptions. The size of these larger cones suggests periods of intense volcanic activity, after which we can infer, based on what we know, that the fires of Etna have remained inactive for many years—since almost a century of dormancy has sometimes followed a major eruption in recorded history. It's also important to note that out of the small number of eruptions that happen in a century, only one is estimated to come from the summit of Etna for every two that occur on the sides. Furthermore, not all of the lateral eruptions create cones that would be considered among the smallest of the eighty hills mentioned; some produce only minor mounds, which are quickly buried by layers of ash.

423 How many years then must we not suppose to have been expended in the formation of the eighty cones? It is difficult to imagine that a fourth part of them have originated during the last thirty centuries. But if we conjecture the whole of them to have been formed in twelve thousand years, how inconsiderable an era would this portion of time constitute in the history of the volcano! If we could strip off from Etna all the lateral monticules now visible, together with the lavas and scoriæ that have been poured out from them, and from the highest crater, during the period of their growth, the diminution of the entire mass would be extremely slight: Etna might lose, perhaps, several miles in diameter at its base, and some hundreds of feet in elevation; but it would still be the loftiest of Sicilian mountains, studded with other cones, which would be recalled, as it were, into existence by the removal of the rocks under which they are now buried.

423 So, how many years should we think have gone into the creation of the eighty cones? It's hard to believe that even a quarter of them formed in the last thirty centuries. But if we assume that all of them were created over twelve thousand years, that time span would be pretty minimal in the context of the volcano's history! If we could somehow remove all the visible side mounds along with the lava and ash that have come from them and the highest crater during their growth, the overall reduction in the volcano's mass would be very small: Etna might shrink by a few miles at its base and lose a few hundred feet in height, but it would still be the tallest mountain in Sicily, with other cones that would be as if brought back to life from beneath the rocks where they are currently hidden.

There seems nothing in the deep sections of the Val del Bove to indicate that the lava-currents of remote periods were greater in volume than those of modern times; and there are abundant proofs that the countless beds of solid rock and scoriæ were accumulated, as now, in succession. On the grounds, therefore, already explained, we must infer that a mass so many thousand feet in thickness must have required an immense series of ages anterior to our historical periods for its growth; yet the whole must be regarded as the product of a modern portion of the tertiary epoch. Such, at least, is the conclusion that seems to follow from geological data, which show that the oldest parts of the mountain, if not of posterior date to the marine strata around its base, were at least of coeval origin.

There doesn't seem to be anything in the deep sections of the Val del Bove to suggest that the lava flows from ancient times were larger than those today; in fact, there are plenty of indications that the many layers of solid rock and scoria were formed, just like today, in succession. Based on the reasons already discussed, we must conclude that a mass so many thousands of feet thick must have taken an enormous amount of time to form, long before our recorded history; still, it should be viewed as the result of a more recent phase of the tertiary period. At least, that’s the conclusion that appears to be supported by geological evidence, which shows that the oldest parts of the mountain, if they aren't younger than the marine layers at its base, were at least formed around the same time.

Some geologists contend, that the sudden elevation of large continents from beneath the waters of the sea have again and again produced waves which have swept over vast regions of the earth.582 But it is clear that no devastating wave has passed over the forest zone of Etna since any of the lateral cones before mentioned were thrown up; for none of these heaps of loose sand and scoriæ could have resisted for a moment the denuding action of a violent flood. To some, perhaps, it may appear that hills of such incoherent materials cannot be of very great antiquity, because the mere action of the atmosphere must, in the course of several thousand years, have obliterated their original forms. But there is no weight in this objection; for the older hills are covered with trees and herbage, which protect them from waste; and, in regard to the newer ones, such is the porosity of their component materials, that the rain which falls upon them is instantly absorbed; and for the same reason that the rivers on Etna have a subterranean course, there are none descending the sides of the minor cones.

Some geologists argue that the sudden rise of large continents from beneath the ocean has repeatedly created waves that have swept over vast areas of the earth.582 However, it's clear that no destructive wave has impacted the forested area of Etna since any of the previously mentioned lateral cones were formed; none of these piles of loose sand and ash could withstand the erosive force of a violent flood for even a moment. To some, it may seem that hills made of such loose materials can't be very old, as the effects of the atmosphere over thousands of years would likely have eroded their original shapes. But this argument doesn't hold up; the older hills are covered with trees and vegetation that protect them from erosion. As for the newer ones, their porous materials absorb rain instantly, and for the same reason that the rivers on Etna flow underground, there are none running down the sides of the smaller cones.

No sensible alteration has been observed in the form of these cones since the earliest periods of which there are memorials; and there seems no reason for anticipating that in the course of the next ten 424 thousand or twenty thousand years they will undergo any great alteration in their appearance, unless they should be shattered by earthquakes or covered by volcanic ejections.

No significant changes have been seen in the shape of these cones since the earliest records we have, and there’s no reason to expect that over the next ten 424 thousand or twenty thousand years they will change much in appearance, unless they are destroyed by earthquakes or buried by volcanic eruptions.

In other parts of Europe, as in Auvergne and Velay, in France, similar loose cones of scoriæ, probably of as high antiquity as the whole mass of Etna, stand uninjured at inferior elevations above the level of the sea.

In other parts of Europe, like Auvergne and Velay in France, similar loose cones of scoria, likely just as ancient as the entire mass of Etna, remain intact at lower elevations above sea level.


CHAPTER XXVI.

Volcanic eruption in Iceland in 1783—New island thrown up—Lava currents of Skaptár Jokul, in same year—their immense volume—Eruption of Jorullo in Mexico—Humboldt's theory of the convexity of the plain of Malpais—Eruption of Galongoon in Java—Submarine volcanoes—Graham island, formed in 1831—Volcanic archipelagoes—Submarine eruptions in mid-Atlantic—The Canaries—Teneriffe—Cones thrown up in Lancerote, 1730-36—Santorin and its contiguous isles—Barren island in the Bay of Bengal—Mud volcanoes—Mineral composition of volcanic products.

Volcanic eruption in Iceland in 1783—New island created—Lava flows of Skaptár Jokul, in the same year—their massive volume—Eruption of Jorullo in Mexico—Humboldt's theory about the shape of the Malpais plain—Eruption of Galongoon in Java—Underwater volcanoes—Graham Island, formed in 1831—Volcanic archipelagos—Underwater eruptions in the mid-Atlantic—The Canaries—Tenerife—Cones formed in Lanzarote, 1730-36—Santorini and its nearby islands—Barren Island in the Bay of Bengal—Mud volcanoes—Chemical makeup of volcanic materials.

Volcanic eruptions in Iceland.—With the exception of Etna and Vesuvius, the most complete chronological records of a series of eruptions are those of Iceland, for their history reaches as far back as the ninth century of our era; and, from the beginning of the twelfth century, there is clear evidence that, during the whole period, there has never been an interval of more than forty, and very rarely one of twenty years, without either an eruption or a great earthquake. So intense is the energy of the volcanic action in this region, that some eruptions of Hecla have lasted six years without ceasing. Earthquakes have often shaken the whole island at once, causing great changes in the interior, such as the sinking down of hills, the rending of mountains, the desertion by rivers of their channels, and the appearance of new lakes.583 New islands have often been thrown up near the coast, some of which still exist; while others have disappeared, either by subsidence or the action of the waves.

Volcanic eruptions in Iceland.—Aside from Etna and Vesuvius, the most comprehensive chronological records of a series of eruptions come from Iceland, as their history goes back to the ninth century. From the early twelfth century onward, there is clear proof that throughout this entire period, there has never been a gap of more than forty years—and very rarely just twenty years—without an eruption or a significant earthquake. The volcanic activity in this area is so intense that some eruptions from Hecla have lasted six consecutive years. Earthquakes have frequently shaken the entire island at once, leading to major changes in the landscape, such as hills sinking, mountains breaking apart, rivers abandoning their paths, and new lakes forming. 583 New islands have often emerged near the coast, some of which still exist while others have vanished due to sinking or the effects of waves.

In the interval between eruptions, innumerable hot springs afford vent to subterranean heat, and solfataras discharge copious streams of inflammable matter. The volcanoes in different parts of this island are observed, like those of the Phlegræan Fields, to be in activity by turns, one vent often serving for a time as a safety-valve to the rest. Many cones are often thrown up in one eruption, and in this case they take a linear direction, running generally from northeast to southwest, from the northeastern part of the island, where the volcano Krabla lies, to the promontory Reykianas.

In the time between eruptions, countless hot springs release underground heat, and solfataras emit large amounts of flammable material. The volcanoes in various parts of this island are seen, like those in the Phlegræan Fields, to be active at different times, with one vent often acting as a safety valve for the others. Many cones can form during a single eruption, and they usually align in a linear path, extending from northeast to southwest, starting from the northeastern part of the island, where the volcano Krabla is located, down to the Reykianas peninsula.

425 New island thrown up in 1783.—The convulsions of the year 1783 appear to have been more tremendous than any recorded in the modern annals of Iceland; and the original Danish narrative of the catastrophe, drawn up in great detail, has since been substantiated by several English travellers, particularly in regard to the prodigious extent of country laid waste, and the volume of lava produced.584 About a month previous to the eruption on the mainland, a submarine volcano burst forth in the sea in lat. 63° 25' N., long. 23° 44' W., at a distance of thirty miles in a southwest direction from Cape Reykianas, and ejected so much pumice, that the ocean was covered with that substance to the distance of 150 miles, and ships were considerably impeded in their course. A new island was thrown up, consisting of high cliffs, within which fire, smoke, and pumice were emitted from two or three different points. This island was claimed by his Danish Majesty, who denominated it Nyöe, or the New Island; but before a year had elapsed, the sea resumed its ancient domain, and nothing was left but a reef of rocks from five to thirty fathoms under water.

425 New island created in 1783.—The upheavals of 1783 seem to have been more intense than any documented in the modern history of Iceland; and the original Danish account of the disaster, written in great detail, has since been confirmed by several English travelers, especially regarding the vast areas of land devastated and the amount of lava produced.584 About a month prior to the eruption on the mainland, a submarine volcano erupted in the ocean at lat. 63° 25' N., long. 23° 44' W., approximately thirty miles southwest of Cape Reykianas, and released so much pumice that the ocean was covered with it for a distance of 150 miles, significantly hindering ships' navigation. A new island emerged, featuring high cliffs, from which fire, smoke, and pumice were expelled from two or three different spots. This island was claimed by the Danish King, who named it Nyöe, or the New Island; however, within a year, the sea reclaimed its territory, leaving only a reef of rocks submerged five to thirty fathoms underwater.

Great eruption of Skaptár Jokul.—Earthquakes which had long been felt in Iceland, became violent on the 11th of June, 1783, when Skaptár Jokul, distant nearly 200 miles from Nyöe, threw out a torrent of lava which flowed down into the river Skaptâ, and completely dried it up. The channel of the river was between high rocks, in many places from four hundred to six hundred feet in depth, and near two hundred in breadth. Not only did the lava fill up this great defile to the brink, but it overflowed the adjacent fields to a considerable extent. The burning flood, on issuing from the confined rocky gorge, was then arrested for some time by a deep lake, which formerly existed in the course of the river, between Skaptardal and Aa, which it entirely filled. The current then advanced again, and reaching some ancient lava full of subterraneous caverns, penetrated and melted down part of it; and in some places, where the steam could not gain vent, it blew up the rock, throwing fragments to the height of more than 150 feet. On the 18th of June another ejection of liquid lava rushed from the volcano, which flowed down with amazing velocity over the surface of the first stream. By the damming up of the mouths of some of the tributaries of the Skaptâ, many villages were completely overflowed with water, and thus great destruction of property was caused. The lava, after flowing for several days, was precipitated down a tremendous cataract called Stapafoss, where it filled a profound abyss, which that great waterfall had 426 been hollowing out for ages, and after this, the fiery current again continued its course.

Great eruption of Skaptár Jokul.—Earthquakes that had been felt in Iceland for a long time turned violent on June 11, 1783, when Skaptár Jokul, nearly 200 miles from Nyöe, erupted and released a torrent of lava that flowed into the Skaptâ river, completely drying it up. The river's channel, bordered by high rocks, was between four hundred and six hundred feet deep and about two hundred feet wide in many places. Not only did the lava fill this massive gorge to the top, but it also overflowed into the nearby fields significantly. The burning flow, upon escaping the narrow rocky gorge, was momentarily stopped by a deep lake that used to exist along the river’s path, between Skaptardal and Aa, which it entirely filled. The current then moved on, reaching some ancient lava filled with underground caves, melting part of it; where steam couldn't escape, it blew up the rock, launching fragments over 150 feet into the air. On June 18, another outpouring of liquid lava surged from the volcano, flowing rapidly over the surface of the first stream. The blockage of some tributary outlets of the Skaptâ caused several villages to be completely flooded, resulting in significant property damage. After flowing for several days, the lava cascaded down a massive waterfall known as Stapafoss, filling a deep chasm that the waterfall had been eroding for ages, and then the fiery flow continued its journey.

On the third of August, fresh floods of lava still pouring from the volcano, a new branch was sent off in a different direction; for the channel of the Skaptâ was now so entirely choked up, and every opening to the west and north so obstructed, that the melted matter was forced to take a new course, so that it ran in a southeast direction, and discharged itself into the bed of the river Hverfisfliot, where a scene of destruction scarcely inferior to the former was occasioned. These Icelandic lavas (like the ancient streams which are met with in Auvergne, and other provinces of Central France), are stated by Stephenson to have accumulated to a prodigious depth in narrow rocky gorges; but when they came to wide alluvial plains, they spread themselves out into broad burning lakes, sometimes from twelve to fifteen miles wide, and one hundred feet deep. When the "fiery lake" which filled up the lower portion of the valley of the Skaptâ, had been augmented by new supplies, the lava flowed up the course of the river to the foot of the hills from whence the Skaptâ takes its rise. This affords a parallel case to one which can be shown to have happened at a remote era in the volcanic region of the Vivarais in France, where lava issued from the cone of Thueyts, and while one branch ran down, another more powerful stream flowed up the channel of the river Ardêche.

On August 3rd, with fresh lava still pouring from the volcano, a new flow was directed in a different path; the Skaptá channel was completely blocked, and every outlet to the west and north was obstructed, forcing the molten material to take a new route, flowing southeast and spilling into the riverbed of Hverfisfliot, creating a scene of destruction nearly as severe as the previous one. These Icelandic lavas (similar to the ancient flows found in Auvergne and other areas of Central France) are reported by Stephenson to have built up to an incredible depth in narrow rocky gorges; however, when they reached wide alluvial plains, they spread out into vast pools of molten rock, sometimes 12 to 15 miles wide and 100 feet deep. When the "fiery lake," which filled the lower part of the Skaptá valley, grew with new supplies, the lava flowed up the riverbed to the base of the hills where the Skaptá originates. This is comparable to an event recorded to have occurred a long time ago in the volcanic area of Vivarais in France, where lava flowed from the Thueyts cone, and while one stream ran downhill, another more powerful flow moved upstream in the Ardèche river channel.

The sides of the valley of the Skaptâ present superb ranges of basaltic columns of older lava, resembling those which are laid open in the valleys descending from Mont Dor, in Auvergne, where more modern lava-currents, on a scale very inferior in magnitude to those of Iceland, have also usurped the beds of the existing rivers. The eruption of Skaptár Jokul did not entirely cease till the end of two years; and when Mr. Paulson visited the tract eleven years afterwards, in 1794, he found columns of smoke still rising from parts of the lava, and several rents filled with hot water.585

The sides of the valley of Skaptâ showcase stunning ranges of basalt columns made from older lava, similar to those found in the valleys leading down from Mont Dor in Auvergne. There, more recent lava flows, though much smaller than those in Iceland, have also overtaken the riverbeds. The eruption of Skaptár Jokul didn't completely stop until two years later, and when Mr. Paulson visited the area eleven years after that, in 1794, he noticed columns of smoke still rising from sections of the lava and several cracks filled with hot water.585

Although the population of Iceland was very much scattered, and did not exceed fifty thousand, no less than twenty villages were destroyed, besides those inundated by water; and more than nine thousand human beings perished, together with an immense number of cattle, partly by the depredations of the lava, partly by the noxious vapors which impregnated the air, and, in part, by the famine caused by showers of ashes throughout the island, and the desertion of the coasts by the fish.

Although the population of Iceland was quite scattered and didn't exceed fifty thousand, at least twenty villages were destroyed, in addition to those flooded by water. More than nine thousand people lost their lives, along with a huge number of cattle. This happened partly due to the damage caused by the lava, partly from the toxic fumes that filled the air, and partly from the famine brought on by ash showers across the island and the abandonment of the coasts by fish.

Immense volume of the lava.—But the extraordinary volume of melted matter produced in this eruption deserves the particular attention of the geologist. Of the two branches, which flowed in nearly opposite directions, the greatest was fifty, and the lesser forty miles in length. The extreme breadth which the Skaptâ branch attained in the low countries was from twelve to fifteen miles, that of the other about seven. The ordinary height of both currents was one hundred feet, but in narrow 427 defiles it sometimes amounted to six hundred. Professor Bischoff has calculated that the mass of lava brought up from the subterranean regions by this single eruption "surpassed in magnitude the bulk of Mont Blanc."586 But a more distinct idea will be formed of the dimensions of the two streams, if we consider how striking a feature they would now form in the geology of England, had they been poured out on the bottom of the sea after the deposition and before the elevation of our secondary and tertiary rocks. The same causes which have excavated valleys through parts of our marine strata, once continuous, might have acted with equal force on the igneous rocks, leaving, at the same time, a sufficient portion undestroyed to enable us to discover their former extent. Let us, then, imagine the termination of the Skaptá branch of lava to rest on the escarpment of the inferior and middle oolite, where it commands the vale of Gloucester. The great platform might be one hundred feet thick, and from ten to fifteen miles broad, exceeding any which can be found in Central France. We may also suppose great tabular masses to occur at intervals, capping the summit of the Cotswold Hills between Gloucester and Oxford, by Northleach, Burford, and other towns. The wide valley of the Oxford clay would then occasion an interruption for many miles; but the same rocks might recur on the summit of Cumnor and Shotover Hills, and all the other oolitic eminences of that district. On the chalk of Berkshire, extensive plateaus, six or seven miles wide, would again be formed; and lastly, crowning the highest sands of Highgate and Hampstead, we might behold some remnants of the current five or six hundred feet in thickness, causing those hills to rival, or even to surpass, in height, Salisbury Craigs and Arthur's Seat.

Massive volume of lava.—The incredible amount of melted material produced in this eruption really grabs the attention of geologists. Of the two branches that flowed in almost opposite directions, the longest was fifty miles, and the shorter one was forty miles long. The Skaptâ branch reached a width of twelve to fifteen miles in the lowlands, while the other was about seven miles wide. Typically, both flows were about a hundred feet high, but in narrow gorges, they occasionally reached six hundred feet. Professor Bischoff calculated that the amount of lava brought up from underground during this one eruption "was larger than the volume of Mont Blanc."586 To get a clearer picture of the size of the two streams, think about how significant they would be in the geology of England if they had poured out on the seabed after sediment was laid down and before our secondary and tertiary rocks were uplifted. The same forces that carved valleys through parts of our former marine layers, which were once continuous, might have acted similarly on the volcanic rocks, leaving enough intact for us to see how far they originally extended. So, let’s imagine the end of the Skaptá lava branch resting on the edge of the lower and middle oolite, overlooking the Vale of Gloucester. The large platform might have been one hundred feet thick and from ten to fifteen miles wide, larger than any found in Central France. We can also picture large flat masses appearing intermittently, topping the Cotswold Hills between Gloucester and Oxford, near Northleach, Burford, and other towns. The broad valley of the Oxford clay would create a break for many miles, but similar rocks could reappear on the summits of Cumnor and Shotover Hills, along with all the other oolitic high points in that area. On the chalk of Berkshire, wide plateaus, six or seven miles across, would form again; and finally, at the highest sands of Highgate and Hampstead, we might see some remnants of the flow that are five or six hundred feet thick, making those hills comparable to or even taller than Salisbury Craigs and Arthur's Seat.

The distance between the extreme points here indicated would not exceed ninety miles in a direct line; and we might then add, at the distance of nearly two hundred miles from London, along the coast of Dorsetshire and Devonshire, for example, a great mass of igneous rocks, to represent those of contemporary origin, which were produced beneath the level of the sea, where the island of Nyöe rose up.

The distance between the farthest points mentioned here would not be more than ninety miles in a straight line; and we could also include, almost two hundred miles from London, along the coast of Dorset and Devon, for instance, a large amount of volcanic rocks, to represent those of current origin, which were formed below sea level, where the island of Nyöe emerged.

Volume of ancient and modern flows of lava compared.—Yet, gigantic as must appear the scale of these modern volcanic operations, we must be content to regard them as perfectly insignificant in comparison to currents of the primeval ages, if we embrace the theoretical views of many geologists, which were not inaccurately expressed by the late Professor Alexander Brongniart, when he declared that "aux époques géognostiques anciennes, tous les phénomènes géologiques se passoient dans des dimensions centuples de celles qu'ils présentent aujourd'hui."587 Had Skaptár Jokul, therefore, been a volcano of the olden time, it would have poured forth lavas at a single eruption a hundred times more voluminous than those which were witnessed by the present generation in 428 1783. But it may, on the contrary, be affirmed that, among the older formations, no igneous rock of such colossal magnitude has yet been met with; nay, it would be most difficult to point out a mass of ancient date (distinctly referable to a single eruption) which would even rival in volume the matter poured out from Skaptár Jokul in 1783.

Comparison of ancient and modern lava flows.—Although the scale of modern volcanic activity may seem massive, we must acknowledge that it is quite small in comparison to the flows from ancient times, if we accept the theories of many geologists. The late Professor Alexander Brongniart aptly stated that "in ancient geological times, all geological phenomena occurred at dimensions hundreds of times greater than those we see today."587 Therefore, if Skaptár Jokul had been a volcano in ancient times, it would have erupted lavas at a single event that were a hundred times more voluminous than those observed by our current generation in 428 1783. However, it can also be argued that, among the older formations, no igneous rock of such immense size has been found; indeed, it would be very challenging to identify a mass from ancient times (clearly attributed to a single eruption) that could even compete in volume with the material released from Skaptár Jokul in 1783.

Eruption of Jorullo in 1759.—As another example of the stupendous scale of modern volcanic eruptions, I may mention that of Jorullo in Mexico, in 1759. The great region to which this mountain belongs has already been described. The plain of Malpais forms part of an elevated platform, between two and three thousand feet above the level of the sea, and is bounded by hills composed of basalt, trachyte, and volcanic tuff, clearly indicating that the country had previously, though probably at a remote period, been the theatre of igneous action. From the era of the discovery of the New World to the middle of the last century, the district had remained undisturbed, and the space, now the site of the volcano, which is thirty-six leagues distant from the nearest sea, was occupied by fertile fields of sugar-cane and indigo, and watered by the two brooks Cuitimba and San Pedro. In the month of June, 1759, hollow sounds of an alarming nature were heard, and earthquakes succeeded each other for two months, until, at the end of September, flames issued from the ground, and fragments of burning rocks were thrown to prodigious heights. Six volcanic cones, composed of scoriæ and fragmentary lava, were formed on the line of a chasm which ran in the direction from N. N. E. to S. S. W. The least of these cones was 300 feet in height; and Jorullo, the central volcano, was elevated 1600 feet above the level of the plain. It sent forth great streams of basaltic lava, containing included fragments of granitic rocks, and its ejections did not cease till the month of February, 1760.588

Eruption of Jorullo in 1759.—Another striking example of modern volcanic eruptions is the one at Jorullo in Mexico, which occurred in 1759. The expansive region that this mountain belongs to has already been described. The Malpais plain is part of a high plateau, between two and three thousand feet above sea level, bordered by hills made of basalt, trachyte, and volcanic tuff, clearly showing that this area was previously the site of volcanic activity, likely a long time ago. From the discovery of the New World until the middle of the last century, the area remained undisturbed, and the land, now where the volcano sits, was filled with fertile fields of sugar cane and indigo, nourished by the two streams, Cuitimba and San Pedro. In June 1759, alarming hollow sounds were heard, followed by a series of earthquakes for two months, until at the end of September, flames burst from the ground, and chunks of burning rock were hurled to incredible heights. Six volcanic cones, made of scoria and fragmented lava, appeared along a fissure that extended from N.N.E. to S.S.W. The smallest of these cones stood at 300 feet tall, and Jorullo, the central volcano, rose 1600 feet above the plain. It released vast flows of basaltic lava, containing fragments of granite, and its eruptions continued until February 1760.588

Fig. 57.Summit of Jorullo.

a, Summit of Jorullo. b, c, Inclined plane sloping at an angle of 6° from the base of the cones.

a, Summit of Jorullo. b, c, Inclined plane sloping at an angle of 6° from the base of the cones.

Humboldt visited the country more than forty years after this occurrence, and was informed by the Indians, that when they returned, long after the catastrophe, to the plain, they found the ground uninhabitable from the excessive heat. When he himself visited the place, there appeared, around the base of the cones, and spreading from them, as from a centre, over an extent of four square miles, a mass of matter of a convex form, about 550 feet high at its junction with the cones, and gradually sloping from them in all directions towards the plain. This mass was still in a heated state, the temperature in the fissures being on the decrease from year to year, but in 1780 it was still sufficient to light a cigar at the depth of a few inches. On this slightly convex protuberance, 429 the slope of which must form an angle of about 6° with the horizon, were thousands of flattish conical mounds, from six to nine feet high, which, as well as large fissures traversing the plain, acted as fumeroles, giving out clouds of sulphurous acid and hot aqueous vapor. The two small rivers before mentioned disappeared during the eruption, losing themselves below the eastern extremity of the plain, and reappearing as hot springs at its western limit.

Humboldt visited the area more than forty years after this event and was told by the Native Americans that when they returned, long after the disaster, they found the land uninhabitable due to the extreme heat. When he visited the site himself, he noticed a mass of material with a convex shape, about 550 feet high at its connection with the cones, spreading out from them over an area of four square miles. This mass was still warm, with the temperature in the cracks decreasing year by year, but in 1780, it was still hot enough to light a cigar just a few inches deep. On this slightly raised area, 429 sloping at about a 6° angle from the horizon, there were thousands of flat, cone-shaped mounds, ranging from six to nine feet high. These mounds, along with large cracks running across the plain, acted as fumaroles, emitting clouds of sulfuric acid and hot water vapor. The two small rivers mentioned earlier disappeared during the eruption, flowing underground at the eastern edge of the plain and reemerging as hot springs at the western end.

Cause of the convexity of the plain of Malpais.—Humboldt attributed the convexity of the plain to inflation from below; supposing the ground, for four square miles in extent, to have risen up in the shape of a bladder to the elevation of 550 feet above the plain in the highest part. But Mr. Scrope has suggested that the phenomena may be accounted for far more naturally, by supposing that lava flowing simultaneously from the different orifices, and principally from Jorullo, united into a sort of pool or lake. As they were poured forth on a surface previously flat, they would, if their liquidity was not very great, remain thickest and deepest near their source, and diminish in bulk from thence towards the limits of the space which they covered. Fresh supplies were probably emitted successively during the course of an eruption which lasted more than half a year; and some of these, resting on those first emitted, might only spread to a small distance from the foot of the cone, where they would necessarily accumulate to a great height. The average slope of the great dome-shaped volcanoes of the Sandwich Islands, formed almost exclusively of lava, with scarce any scoriæ, is between 6° 30' and 7° 46', so that the inclination of the convex mass around Jorullo, if we adopt Mr. Scrope's explanation (see fig. 57), is quite in accordance with the known laws which govern the flow of lava.

Cause of the convexity of the plain of Malpais.—Humboldt suggested that the convex shape of the plain was due to inflation from underneath, imagining that the ground, covering four square miles, rose like a bladder to a height of 550 feet above the plain at its highest point. However, Mr. Scrope proposed a more straightforward explanation: the observed phenomena could be explained by the idea that lava flowing from different openings, primarily from Jorullo, came together to form a sort of pool or lake. As the lava spread across a previously flat surface, if it wasn't very liquid, it would likely be thickest and deepest near its source, decreasing in volume as it extended outward. It's likely that new lava was emitted throughout an eruption lasting over six months; some of this lava, settling on the earlier flows, might have only spread a short distance from the foot of the cone, causing a significant buildup in height. The average slope of the large dome-shaped volcanoes in the Sandwich Islands, primarily made of lava with very little scoria, is between 6° 30' and 7° 46', making the slope of the convex mass around Jorullo consistent with the established principles of lava flow, according to Mr. Scrope's theory (see fig. 57).

The showers, also, of loose and pulverulent matter from the six craters, and principally from Jorullo, would be composed of heavier and more bulky particles near the cones, and would raise the ground at their base, where, mixing with rain, they might have given rise to the stratum of black clay, which is described as covering the lava. The small conical mounds (called "hornitos," or little ovens) may resemble those five or six small hillocks which existed in 1823 on the Vesuvian lava, and sent forth columns of vapor, having been produced by the disengagement of elastic fluids heaping up small dome-shaped masses of lava. The fissures mentioned by Humboldt as of frequent occurrence, are such as might naturally accompany the consolidation of a thick bed of lava, contracting as it congeals; and the disappearance of rivers is the usual result of the occupation of the lower part of a valley or plain by lava, of which there are many beautiful examples in the old lava-currents of Auvergne. The heat of the "hornitos" is stated to have diminished from the first; and Mr. Bullock, who visited the spot many years after Humboldt, found the temperature of the hot spring very low,—a fact which seems clearly to indicate the gradual congelation of a subjacent bed of lava, which from its immense thickness may have been enabled to retain its heat for half a century. The reader may be 430 reminded, that when we thus suppose the lava near the volcano to have been, together with the ejected ashes, more than five hundred feet in depth, we merely assign a thickness which the current of Skaptár Jokul attained in some places in 1783.

The showers of loose and powdery material from the six craters, especially from Jorullo, would consist of heavier and larger particles near the cones, which would raise the ground at their base. When mixed with rain, they could have formed the layer of black clay described as covering the lava. The small conical mounds (called "hornitos," or little ovens) might look like the five or six small hills that were present in 1823 on the Vesuvian lava, which released columns of vapor due to the escape of gases piling up small dome-shaped masses of lava. The cracks mentioned by Humboldt, which occur frequently, naturally accompany the solidification of a thick layer of lava as it contracts while cooling. The disappearance of rivers is a common outcome when lava occupies the lower part of a valley or plain, a phenomenon we can observe in the beautiful examples of the ancient lava flows in Auvergne. The heat of the "hornitos" is said to have lessened over time; Mr. Bullock, who visited the site many years after Humboldt, found the temperature of the hot spring to be quite low, which indicates the gradual cooling of an underlying layer of lava that, due to its considerable thickness, may have been able to retain its heat for about fifty years. The reader should note that when we assume the lava near the volcano to have been, along with the ejected ashes, over five hundred feet deep, we are merely suggesting a thickness that the Skaptár Jokul flow reached in some areas in 1783.

Hollow sound of the plain when struck.—Another argument adduced in support of the theory of inflation from below, was, the hollow sound made by the steps of a horse upon the plain; which, however, proves nothing more than that the materials of which the convex mass is composed are light and porous. The sound called "rimbombo" by the Italians is very commonly returned by made ground when struck sharply; and has been observed not only on the sides of Vesuvius and other volcanic cones where there is a cavity below, but in such regions as the Campagna di Roma, composed in a great measure of tuff and porous volcanic rocks. The reverberation, however, may perhaps be assisted by grottoes and caverns, for these may be as numerous in the lavas of Jorullo as in many of those of Etna; but their existence would lend no countenance to the hypothesis of a great arched cavity, four square miles in extent, and in the centre 550 feet high.589

Hollow sound of the plain when struck.—Another argument in favor of the theory of inflation from below is the hollow sound produced by a horse's footsteps on the plain; however, this only shows that the materials making up the convex mass are light and porous. The sound known as "rimbombo" by Italians is often heard from made ground when struck sharply; it has been noticed not just on the slopes of Vesuvius and other volcanic cones with a cavity below, but also in areas like the Campagna di Roma, which is largely made up of tuff and porous volcanic rocks. The echo, though, may be enhanced by grottoes and caverns, which could be as common in the lavas of Jorullo as they are in those of Etna; but their existence would provide no support for the theory of a vast arched cavity, measuring four square miles and rising 550 feet in the center.589

No recent eruptions of Jorullo.—In a former edition I stated that I had been informed by Captain Vetch, that in 1819 a tower at Guadalaxara was thrown down by an earthquake, and that ashes, supposed to have come from Jorullo, fell at the same time at Guanaxuato, a town situated 140 English miles from the volcano. But Mr. Burkhardt, a German director of mines, who examined Jorullo in 1827, ascertained that there had been no eruption there since Humboldt's visit in 1803. He went to the bottom of the crater, and observed a slight evolution of sulphurous acid vapors, but the "hornitos" had entirely ceased to send forth steam. During the twenty-four years intervening between his visit and that of Humboldt, vegetation had made great progress on the flanks of the new hills; the rich soil of the surrounding country was once more covered with luxuriant crops of sugar-cane and indigo, and there was an abundant growth of natural underwood on all the uncultivated tracts.590

No recent eruptions of Jorullo.—In a previous edition, I mentioned that Captain Vetch had informed me that in 1819, an earthquake caused a tower in Guadalajara to collapse, and that ashes, believed to have come from Jorullo, fell at the same time in Guanajuato, a town located 140 English miles from the volcano. However, Mr. Burkhardt, a German mining director who examined Jorullo in 1827, found that there had been no eruptions since Humboldt's visit in 1803. He went to the bottom of the crater and noted a slight release of sulfuric acid vapors, but the "hornitos" had completely stopped emitting steam. During the twenty-four years between his visit and Humboldt's, vegetation had thrived on the slopes of the new hills; the fertile soil of the surrounding area was once again covered with lush crops of sugar cane and indigo, and there was a rich growth of natural underbrush in all the uncultivated areas.590

Galongoon, Java, 1822.—The mountain of Galongoon (or Galung Gung) was in 1822 covered by a dense forest, and situated in a fruitful and thickly-peopled part of Java. There was a circular hollow at its summit, but no tradition existed of any former eruption. In July, 1822, the waters of the river Kunir, one of those which flowed from its flanks, became for a time hot and turbid. On the 8th of October following a loud explosion was heard, the earth shook, and immense columns of hot water and boiling mud, mixed with burning brimstone, ashes, and lapilli, of the size of nuts, were projected from the mountain like a waterspout, with such prodigious violence that large quantities fell beyond the river Tandoi, which is forty miles distant. Every valley within the range of 431 this eruption became filled with a burning torrent, and the rivers, swollen with hot water and mud, overflowed their banks, and carried away great numbers of the people, who were endeavoring to escape, and the bodies of cattle, wild beasts, and birds. A space of twenty-four miles between the mountain and the river Tandoi was covered to such a depth with bluish mud that people were buried in their houses, and not a trace of the numerous villages and plantations throughout that extent was visible. Within this space the bodies of those who perished were buried in mud and concealed, but near the limits of the volcanic action they were exposed, and strewed over the ground in great numbers, partly boiled and partly burnt.

Galongoon, Java, 1822.—In 1822, Galongoon Mountain (or Galung Gung) was covered by a thick forest and located in a fertile, densely populated area of Java. At its peak, there was a circular depression, but no stories about any past eruptions existed. In July 1822, the waters of the Kunir River, which flowed from its slopes, became hot and muddy for a while. On October 8, a loud explosion was heard, the ground shook, and massive columns of hot water and boiling mud, mixed with burning sulfur, ashes, and nut-sized volcanic rock, erupted from the mountain like a waterspout with such incredible force that large amounts fell beyond the Tandoi River, which was forty miles away. Every valley affected by this eruption was filled with a burning flood, and the rivers, swollen with hot water and mud, overflowed their banks, sweeping away many people trying to escape, along with the bodies of livestock, wild animals, and birds. An area of twenty-four miles between the mountain and the Tandoi River was covered in bluish mud to such a depth that people were buried in their homes, and no signs of the many villages and farms in that area were visible. Within this expanse, the bodies of those who died were buried in mud and hidden, but near the edges of the volcanic activity, they were exposed and scattered across the ground in large numbers, some partially boiled and some charred.

It was remarked, that the boiling mud and cinders were projected with such violence from the mountain, that while many remote villages were utterly destroyed and buried, others much nearer the volcano were scarcely injured.

It was noted that the boiling mud and ash were forced out of the mountain with such force that while many distant villages were completely destroyed and buried, others much closer to the volcano were hardly affected.

The first eruption lasted nearly five hours, and on the following days the rain fell in torrents, and the rivers, densely charged with mud, deluged the country far and wide. At the end of four days (October 12th) a second eruption occurred more violent than the first, in which hot water and mud were again vomited, and great blocks of basalt were thrown to the distance of seven miles from the volcano. There was at the same time a violent earthquake, and in one account it is stated that the face of the mountain was utterly changed, its summits broken down, and one side, which had been covered with trees, became an enormous gulf in the form of a semicircle. This cavity was about midway between the summit and the plain, and surrounded by steep rocks, said to be newly heaped up during the eruption. New hills and valleys are said to have been formed, and the rivers Banjarang and Wulan changed their course, and in one night (October 12th) 2000 persons were killed.

The first eruption lasted almost five hours, and in the days that followed, it poured rain heavily, causing the rivers to flood the area with mud. After four days (October 12th), a second eruption occurred that was more intense than the first, blasting out hot water and mud, as well as throwing large chunks of basalt up to seven miles away from the volcano. At the same time, there was a strong earthquake, and one report noted that the mountain's appearance was completely altered, with its peaks crumbling and one side, which had been forested, transforming into a massive semicircular hole. This cavity was roughly halfway between the peak and the plain, surrounded by steep rocks believed to have been formed during the eruption. New hills and valleys reportedly emerged, the rivers Banjarang and Wulan changed their paths, and in just one night (October 12th), 2000 people lost their lives.

The first intimation which the inhabitants of Bandong received of this calamity on the 8th of October, was the news that the river Wulna was bearing down into the sea the dead bodies of men, and the carcasses of stags, rhinoceroses, tigers, and other animals. The Dutch painter Payen determined to travel from thence to the volcano, and he found that the quantity of the ashes diminished as he approached the base of the mountain. He alludes to the altered form of the mountain after the 12th, but does not describe the new semicircular gulf on its side.

The first indication the people of Bandong had of this disaster on October 8th was the news that the Wulna River was carrying the bodies of men and the remains of stags, rhinos, tigers, and other animals out to sea. The Dutch painter Payen decided to travel from there to the volcano, and he noticed that the amount of ash decreased as he got closer to the base of the mountain. He mentions the changed shape of the mountain after the 12th, but he doesn’t describe the new semicircular crater on its side.

The official accounts state that 114 villages were destroyed, and above 4000 persons killed.591

The official reports indicate that 114 villages were destroyed, and over 4000 people were killed.591

Submarine volcanoes.—Although we have every reason to believe that volcanic eruptions as well as earthquakes are common in the bed of the sea, it was not to be expected that many opportunities would occur to scientific observers of witnessing the phenomena. The crews of vessels have sometimes reported that they have seen in different places sulphur 432ous smoke, flame, jets of water, and steam, rising up from the sea, or they have observed the waters greatly discolored, and in a state of violent agitation as if boiling. New shoals have also been encountered, or a reef of rocks just emerging above the surface, where previously there was always supposed to have been deep water. On some few occasions the gradual formation of an island by a submarine eruption has been observed, as that of Sabrina, in the year 1811, off St. Michael's in the Azores. The throwing up of ashes in that case, and the formation of a cone about three hundred feet in height, with a crater in the centre, closely resembled the phenomena usually accompanying a volcanic eruption on land. Sabrina was soon washed away by the waves. Previous eruptions in the same part of the sea were recorded to have happened in 1691 and 1720. The rise of Nyöe, also, a small island off the coast of Iceland, in 1783, has already been alluded to; and another volcanic isle was produced by an eruption near Reikiavig, on the same coast, in June, 1830.592

Submarine volcanoes.—Although we have good reason to think that volcanic eruptions and earthquakes are common on the ocean floor, it was not expected that many chances would arise for scientists to observe these events firsthand. The crews of ships have sometimes reported seeing sulfurous smoke, flames, jets of water, and steam rising from the sea or have noticed the water being heavily discolored and violently agitated, as if it were boiling. New underwater formations have also been found, or a reef of rocks has emerged where there was previously thought to be deep water. On a few occasions, the gradual formation of an island has been observed as a result of a submarine eruption, like that of Sabrina in 1811, near St. Michael's in the Azores. In that case, the eruption produced ash and formed a cone about three hundred feet high, with a crater at the center, closely resembling the phenomena typically seen during volcanic eruptions on land. Sabrina was quickly washed away by the waves. Previous eruptions in that area of the sea were recorded in 1691 and 1720. The rise of Nyöe, a small island off the coast of Iceland in 1783, has already been mentioned; another volcanic island was formed by an eruption near Reykjavik on the same coast in June 1830.592

Graham Island593, 1831.—We have still more recent and minute information respecting the appearance, in 1831, of a new volcanic island in the Mediterranean, between the S. W. coast of Sicily and that projecting part of the African coast where ancient Carthage stood. The site of the island was not any part of the great shoal, or bank, called "Nerita," as was first asserted, but a spot where Captain W. H. Smyth had found, in his survey a few years before, a depth of more than one hundred fathoms water.594

Graham Island593, 1831.—We now have more recent and detailed information about the emergence, in 1831, of a new volcanic island in the Mediterranean, situated between the southwestern coast of Sicily and the section of the African coast where ancient Carthage was located. The location of the island was not part of the large shoal or bank known as "Nerita," as was initially claimed, but rather an area where Captain W. H. Smyth had previously recorded a depth of over one hundred fathoms in his survey several years earlier.594

Fig. 58.Form of the cliffs of Graham Island.

Form of the cliffs of Graham Island, as seen from S. S. E., distant one mile, 7th August, 1831.596

Form of the cliffs of Graham Island, as seen from S. S. E., one mile away, August 7, 1831.596

Fig. 59.View of the interior of Graham Island.

View of the interior of Graham Island, 29th Sept., 1831.

View of the interior of Graham Island, September 29, 1831.

Fig. 60.Graham Island.

Graham Island, 29th Sept., 1831.597

Graham Island, Sept. 29, 1831.597

The position of the island (lat. 37° 8' 30" N., long. 12° 42' 15" E.) was about thirty miles S. W. of Sciacca, in Sicily, and thirty-three miles N. E. of Pantellaria.595 On the 28th of June, about a fortnight before the eruption was visible, Sir Pulteney Malcolm, in passing over the spot in his ship, felt the shocks of an earthquake, as if he had struck on a sand-bank; and the same shocks were felt on the west coast of Sicily, in a direction from S. W. to N. E. About the 10th of July, John Corrao, the captain of a Sicilian vessel, reported that, as he passed near the place, he saw a column of water like a water-spout, sixty feet high, and 800 yards in circumference, rising from the sea, and soon afterwards a dense steam in its place, which ascended to the height of 1800 feet. The same Corrao, on his return from Girgenti, on the 18th of July, found a small island, twelve feet high with a crater in its centre, ejecting volcanic matter, and immense columns of vapor; the sea around being 433 covered with floating cinders and dead fish. The scoriæ were of a chocolate color, and the water which boiled in the circular basin was of a dingy red. The eruption continued with great violence to the end of the same month; at which time the island was visited by several persons, 434 and among others by Capt. Swinburne, R. N., and M. Hoffmann, the Prussian geologist. It was then from fifty to ninety feet in height, and three-quarters of a mile in circumference. By the 4th of August it became, according to some accounts, above 200 feet high, and three miles in circumference; after which it began to diminish in size by the action of the waves, and it was only two miles round on the 25th of August; and on the 3d of September, when it was carefully examined by Captain Wodehouse, only three-fifths of a mile in circumference; its greatest height being then 107 feet. At this time the crater was about 780 feet in circumference. On the 29th of September, when it was visited by Mons. C. Prevost, its circumference was reduced to about 700 yards. It was composed entirely of incoherent ejected matter, scoriæ, pumice, and lapilli, forming regular strata, some of which are described as having been parallel to the steep inward slope of the crater, while the rest were inclined outwards, like those of Vesuvius.598 When the arrangement of the ejected materials has been determined by their falling continually on two steep slopes, that of the external cone and that of the crater, which is always a hollow inverted cone, a transverse section would probably resemble that given in the annexed figure (61). But when I visited Vesuvius, in 1828, I saw no beds of scoriæ inclined towards the axis of the cone. (See fig. 45, p. 381.) Such may have once existed; but the explosions or subsidences, or whatever causes produced the great crater of 1822, had possibly destroyed them.

The island's location (lat. 37° 8' 30" N., long. 12° 42' 15" E.) was about thirty miles southwest of Sciacca in Sicily, and thirty-three miles northeast of Pantellaria.595 On June 28th, about two weeks before the eruption became visible, Sir Pulteney Malcolm, while passing over the area in his ship, felt the jolt of an earthquake, as if he had hit a sandbank; similar shocks were experienced on the west coast of Sicily, running from southwest to northeast. Around July 10th, John Corrao, the captain of a Sicilian vessel, reported that as he passed near the site, he saw a column of water like a waterspout, sixty feet tall and 800 yards wide, rising from the sea, and shortly after, a dense steam replaced it, rising to a height of 1,800 feet. The same Corrao, on his way back from Girgenti on July 18th, discovered a small island, twelve feet high with a crater in the center, ejecting volcanic material and massive columns of vapor; the surrounding sea was covered with floating cinders and dead fish. The scoria was chocolate-colored, and the water boiling in the circular basin was a dirty red. The eruption continued powerfully until the end of that month; during this time, several people visited the island, including Capt. Swinburne, R. N., and M. Hoffmann, the Prussian geologist. At that time, it was fifty to ninety feet tall and three-quarters of a mile around. By August 4th, it reportedly reached over 200 feet in height and three miles in circumference; after that, it began to shrink in size due to wave action, measuring only two miles around by August 25th, and on September 3rd, when carefully checked by Captain Wodehouse, it was just three-fifths of a mile in circumference, with its greatest height at 107 feet. At that time, the crater was about 780 feet in circumference. On September 29th, when Mons. C. Prevost visited it, the circumference was reduced to around 700 yards. It was made up entirely of loosely ejected materials, scoria, pumice, and lapilli, forming regular layers, some described as being parallel to the steep inward slope of the crater, while others slanted outward, similar to those of Vesuvius.598 Once the arrangement of the ejected materials is established by their continuous fall on two steep slopes—the external cone and the crater, which is always a hollow inverted cone—a cross-section would probably look like that shown in the attached figure (61). However, when I visited Vesuvius in 1828, I did not see any layers of scoria leaning toward the cone's axis. (See fig. 45, p. 381.) They may have once existed, but the explosions or collapses, or whatever caused the large crater of 1822, may have destroyed them.

Fig. 61.Hollow inverted cone.

Few of the pieces of stone thrown out from Graham Island exceeded a foot in diameter. Some fragments of dolomitic limestone were intermixed; but these were the only non-volcanic substances. During the month of August, there occurred on the S. W. side of the new island a violent ebullition and agitation of the sea, accompanied by the constant ascension of a column of dense white steam, indicating the existence of a second vent at no great depth from the surface. Towards the close of October, no vestige of the crater remained, and the island was nearly levelled with the surface of the ocean, with the exception, at one point, of a small monticule of sand and scoriæ. It was reported that, at the commencement of the year following (1832), there was a depth of 150 feet where the island had been: but this account was quite erroneous; for in the early part of that year Captain Swinburne found a shoal and discolored water there, and towards the end of 1833 a dangerous reef existed of an oval figure, about three-fifths of a mile in extent. In the centre was a black rock, of the diameter of about 435 twenty-six fathoms, from nine to eleven feet under water; and round this rock are banks of black volcanic stones and loose sand. At the distance of sixty fathoms from this central mass, the depth increased rapidly. There was also a second shoal at the distance of 450 feet S. W. of the great reef, with fifteen feet water over it, also composed of rock, surrounded by deep sea. We can scarcely doubt that the rock in the middle of the larger reef is solid lava, which rose up in the principal crater, and that the second shoal marks the site of the submarine eruption observed in August, 1831, to the S. W. of the island.

Few of the stones ejected from Graham Island were larger than a foot in diameter. Some pieces of dolomitic limestone were mixed in, but these were the only non-volcanic materials present. In August, the southwestern side of the newly formed island experienced intense bubbling and agitation of the sea, along with a continuous rise of a dense white steam column, indicating there was likely a second vent not far below the surface. By the end of October, there were no traces left of the crater, and the island was nearly leveled with the ocean surface, except for a small mound of sand and scoria at one point. It was reported that at the beginning of the following year (1832), there was a depth of 150 feet where the island used to be, but this account was completely incorrect; in the early part of that year, Captain Swinburne discovered a shoal and discolored water in that location, and by the end of 1833, there was a dangerous oval reef about three-fifths of a mile long. In the center was a black rock, about twenty-six fathoms in diameter, sitting nine to eleven feet underwater, and around this rock were banks of black volcanic stones and loose sand. At a distance of sixty fathoms from this central mass, the depth increased rapidly. There was also a second shoal located 450 feet southwest of the main reef, with fifteen feet of water over it, also made up of rock, surrounded by deep sea. We can hardly doubt that the rock in the middle of the larger reef is solid lava that rose from the main crater, and that the second shoal represents the site of the underwater eruption observed in August 1831, to the southwest of the island.

From the whole of the facts above detailed, it appears that a hill eight hundred feet or more in height was formed by a submarine volcanic vent, of which the upper part (only about two hundred feet high) emerged above the waters, so as to form an island. This cone must have been equal in size to one of the largest of the lateral volcanoes on the flanks of Etna, and about half the height of the mountain Jorullo in Mexico, which was formed in the course of nine months, in 1759. In the centre of the new volcano a large cavity was kept open by gaseous discharges, which threw out scoriæ; and fluid lava probably rose up in this cavity. It is not uncommon for small subsidiary craters to open near the summit of a cone, and one of these may have been formed in the case of Graham Island; a vent, perhaps, connected with the main channel of discharge which gave passage in that direction to elastic fluids, scoriæ, and melted lava. It does not appear that, either from this duct, or from the principal vent, there was any overflowing of lava; but melted rock may have flowed from the flanks or base of the cone (a common occurrence on land), and may have spread in a broad sheet over the bottom of the sea.

From all the facts mentioned above, it seems that a hill over eight hundred feet high was created by a submarine volcanic vent, with its upper part (only about two hundred feet above water) rising to form an island. This cone was likely as large as some of the biggest lateral volcanoes on the sides of Etna and about half the height of Jorullo in Mexico, which formed over nine months in 1759. In the center of the new volcano, a large cavity was kept open by gas discharges, which expelled scoria; fluid lava likely rose in this cavity. It's not unusual for small subsidiary craters to open near the summit of a cone, and one may have formed in the case of Graham Island—a vent perhaps connected to the main discharge channel that allowed elastic fluids, scoria, and melted lava to escape in that direction. It doesn't seem that there was any overflowing lava from this duct or the main vent; however, melted rock might have flowed from the sides or base of the cone (a common occurrence on land) and could have spread out in a broad layer over the seabed.

Fig. 62.Supposed section of Graham Island.

Supposed section of Graham Island. (C. Maclaren.599)

Supposed section of Graham Island. (C. Maclaren.599)

The dotted lines in the annexed figure are an imaginary restoration of the upper part of the cone, now removed by the waves: the strong lines represent the part of the volcano which is still under water: in the centre is a great column, or dike, of solid lava, two hundred feet in diameter, supposed to fill the space by which the gaseous fluids rose; and on each side of the dike is a stratified mass of scoriæ and fragmentary lava. The solid nucleus of the reef, where the black rock is now found, withstands the movements of the sea; while the surrounding loose tuffs are cut away to a somewhat lower level. In this manner the 436 lava, which was the lowest part of the island, or, to speak more correctly, which scarcely ever rose above the level of the sea when the island existed, has now become the highest point in the reef.

The dotted lines in the attached figure are a hypothetical restoration of the upper part of the cone, which has now been eroded by the waves: the solid lines show the part of the volcano that is still underwater: in the center is a large column, or dike, of solid lava, two hundred feet in diameter, which is believed to fill the space where the gas and fluids rose; and on each side of the dike is a layered mass of scoria and fragmented lava. The solid core of the reef, where the black rock is currently found, can resist the movements of the sea; meanwhile, the surrounding loose tuffs have been eroded to a slightly lower level. In this way, the 436 lava, which was the lowest part of the island or, to be more precise, which barely broke the surface of the sea when the island existed, has now become the highest point in the reef.

No appearances observed, either during the eruption or since the island disappeared, gave the least support to the opinion promulgated by some writers, that part of the ancient bed of the sea had been lifted up bodily.

No signs seen, either during the eruption or after the island vanished, supported the view expressed by some writers that a portion of the ancient seabed had been raised up completely.

The solid products, says Dr. John Davy, whether they consisted of sand, light cinders, or vesicular lava, differed more in form than in composition. The lava contained augite; and the specific gravity was 2·07 and 2·70. When the light spongy cinder, which floated on the sea, was reduced to fine powder by trituration, and the greater part of the entangled air got rid of, it was found to be of the specific gravity 2·64; and that of some of the sand which fell in the eruption was 2·75;600 so that the materials equalled ordinary granites in weight and solidity. The only gas evolved in any considerable quantity was carbonic acid.601

The solid products, according to Dr. John Davy, whether made up of sand, light ash, or bubbly lava, varied more in shape than in makeup. The lava had augite in it, and its specific gravity was between 2.07 and 2.70. When the light, spongy ash that floated on the sea was ground into a fine powder, most of the trapped air was removed, resulting in a specific gravity of 2.64; some of the sand that came down during the eruption had a specific gravity of 2.75;600 which means the materials matched ordinary granites in weight and sturdiness. The only gas released in significant amounts was carbon dioxide.601

Submarine eruptions in mid-Atlantic.—In the Nautical Magazine for 1835, p. 642, and for 1838, p. 361, and in the Comptes Rendus, April, 1838, accounts are given of a series of volcanic phenomena, earthquakes, troubled water, floating scoriæ and columns of smoke, which have been observed at intervals since the middle of the last century, in a space of open sea between longitudes 20° and 22° west, about half a degree south of the equator. These facts, says Mr. Darwin, seem to show, that an island or an archipelago is in process of formation in the middle of the Atlantic; a line joining St. Helena and Ascension would, if prolonged, intersect this slowly nascent focus of volcanic action.602 Should land be eventually formed here, it will not be the first that has been produced by igneous action in this ocean since it was inhabited by the existing species of testacea. At Porto Praya in St. Jago, one of the Azores, a horizontal, calcareous stratum occurs, containing shells of recent marine species, covered by a great sheet of basalt eighty feet thick.603 It would be difficult to estimate too highly the commercial and political importance which a group of islands might acquire, if in the next two or three thousand years they should rise in mid-ocean between St. Helena and Ascension.

Submarine eruptions in mid-Atlantic.—In the Nautical Magazine for 1835, p. 642, and for 1838, p. 361, and in the Comptes Rendus, April, 1838, there are reports of a series of volcanic activities, earthquakes, rough waters, floating scoria, and columns of smoke that have been observed at intervals since the middle of the last century, in a stretch of open sea between longitudes 20° and 22° west, about half a degree south of the equator. These observations, according to Mr. Darwin, suggest that an island or an archipelago is forming in the middle of the Atlantic; a line connecting St. Helena and Ascension would, if extended, cross this slowly emerging center of volcanic activity.602 If land eventually forms here, it will not be the first to arise from volcanic activity in this ocean since it was inhabited by the current species of shellfish. At Porto Praya in St. Jago, one of the Azores, there is a horizontal calcareous layer containing shells of recent marine species, covered by a massive layer of basalt eighty feet thick.603 It would be hard to overstate the commercial and political importance that a group of islands might gain if they were to rise in mid-ocean between St. Helena and Ascension over the next two to three thousand years.

CANARY ISLANDS.

Eruption in Lancerote, 1730 to 1736.—The effects of an eruption which happened in Lancerote, one of the Canary Islands, between the years 1730 and 1736, were very remarkable; and a detailed description has been published by Von Buch, who had an opportunity, when he visited that island in 1815, of comparing the accounts transmitted to us of the event, with the present state and geological appearances of the 437 country.604 On the 1st of September, 1730, the earth split open on a sudden two leagues from Yaira. In one night a considerable hill of ejected matter was thrown up; and, a few days later, another vent opened, and gave out a lava-stream, which overran Chinanfaya and other villages. It flowed first rapidly, like water, but became afterwards heavy and slow, like honey. On the 7th of September an immense rock was protruded from the bottom of the lava with a noise like thunder, and the stream was forced to change its course from N. to N. W., so that St. Catalina and other villages were overflowed.

Eruption in Lancerote, 1730 to 1736.—The eruption that took place in Lancerote, one of the Canary Islands, between 1730 and 1736 had very notable effects; a detailed description was published by Von Buch, who, during his visit to the island in 1815, was able to compare the historical accounts of the event with the current conditions and geological features of the 437 country.604 On September 1, 1730, the ground suddenly opened up two leagues from Yaira. In just one night, a significant hill of ejected material formed; a few days later, another vent opened and released a lava flow that covered Chinanfaya and nearby villages. It initially flowed quickly like water, but later became thick and sluggish, like honey. On September 7, a massive rock was thrust up from beneath the lava with a sound like thunder, causing the lava flow to change direction from north to northwest, resulting in the overflow of St. Catalina and other villages.

Whether this mass was protruded by an earthquake, or was a mass of ancient lava, blown up like that before mentioned in 1783 in Iceland, is not explained.

Whether this mass was pushed up by an earthquake, or was a chunk of ancient lava, blown up like the one mentioned before in 1783 in Iceland, is not clear.

On the 11th of September more lava flowed out, and covered the village of Maso entirely, and for the space of eight days precipitated itself with a horrible roar into the sea. Dead fish floated on the waters in indescribable multitudes, or were thrown dying on the shore. After a brief interval of repose, three new openings broke forth immediately from the site of the consumed St. Catalina, and sent out an enormous quantity of lapilli, sand, and ashes. On the 28th of October the cattle throughout the whole country dropped lifeless to the ground, suffocated by putrid vapors, which condensed and fell down in drops. On the 1st of December a lava-stream reached the sea, and formed an island, round which dead fish were strewed.

On September 11th, more lava flowed out, completely covering the village of Maso, and for eight days, it plunged into the sea with a terrible roar. Dead fish floated on the water in unimaginable numbers, or were thrown onto the shore, gasping for breath. After a short period of calm, three new openings erupted from the site where St. Catalina had been, releasing a huge amount of lapilli, sand, and ash. On October 28th, livestock across the entire region collapsed to the ground, suffocated by foul fumes that condensed and fell as droplets. On December 1st, a lava flow reached the sea and created an island, surrounded by dead fish.

Number of cones thrown up.—It is unnecessary here to give the details of the overwhelming of other places by fiery torrents, or of a storm which was equally new and terrifying to the inhabitants, as they had never known one in their country before. On the 10th of January, 1731, a high hill was thrown up, which, on the same day, precipitated itself back again into its own crater; fiery brooks of lava flowed from it to the sea. On the 3d of February a new cone arose. Others were thrown up in March, and poured forth lava-streams. Numerous other volcanic cones were subsequently formed in succession, till at last their number amounted to about thirty. In June, 1731, during a renewal of the eruptions, all the banks and shores in the western part of the island were covered with dying fish, of different species, some of which had never before been seen. Smoke and flame arose from the sea, with loud detonations. These dreadful commotions lasted without interruption for five successive years, so that a great emigration of the inhabitants became necessary.

Number of cones thrown up.—It’s not necessary to detail how other areas were overwhelmed by fiery torrents, or describe a storm that was completely new and terrifying for the locals, as they had never experienced anything like it in their country before. On January 10, 1731, a tall hill was formed, which on the same day collapsed back into its crater; streams of lava flowed from it to the sea. On February 3, a new cone emerged. More were formed in March, releasing lava streams. Many other volcanic cones were subsequently created, totaling around thirty. In June 1731, during a renewal of the eruptions, all the banks and shores in the western part of the island were covered with dying fish of various species, some of which had never been seen before. Smoke and flames rose from the sea, accompanied by loud explosions. These terrifying disturbances continued without pause for five successive years, leading to a mass emigration of the locals.

Their linear direction.—As to the height of the new cones, Von Buch was assured that the formerly great and flourishing St. Catalina lay buried under hills 400 feet in height; and he observes that the most elevated cone of the series rose 600 feet above its base, and 1378 feet above the sea, and that several others were nearly as high. The new 438 vents were all arranged in one line, about two geographical miles long, and in a direction nearly east and west. If we admit the probability of Von Buch's conjecture, that these vents opened along the line of a cleft, it seems necessary to suppose that this subterranean fissure was only prolonged upwards to the surface by degrees, and that the rent was narrow at first, as is usually the case with fissures caused by earthquakes. Lava and elastic fluids might escape from some point on the rent where there was least resistance, till, the first aperture becoming obstructed by ejections and the consolidation of lava, other orifices burst open in succession along the line of the original fissure. Von Buch found that each crater was lowest on that side on which lava had issued; but some craters were not breached, and were without any lava streams. In one of these were open fissures, out of which hot vapors rose, which in 1815 raised the thermometer to 145° Fahrenheit, and was probably at the boiling point lower down. The exhalations seemed to consist of aqueous vapor; yet they could not be pure steam, for the crevices were incrusted on either side by siliceous sinter (an opal-like hydrate of silica of a white color), which extended almost to the middle. This important fact attests the length of time during which chemical processes continue after eruptions, and how open fissures may be filled up laterally by mineral matter, sublimed from volcanic exhalations. The lavas of this eruption covered nearly a third of the whole island, often forming on slightly inclined planes great horizontal sheets several square leagues in area, resembling very much the basaltic platforms of Auvergne.

Their linear direction.—Regarding the height of the new cones, Von Buch learned that the once-great and thriving St. Catalina is buried under hills that rise 400 feet. He notes that the tallest cone in the series reaches 600 feet above its base and 1378 feet above sea level, with several others being almost as tall. The new 438 vents are all arranged in one line, extending about two geographical miles, and aligned roughly east to west. If we accept Von Buch's theory that these vents opened along a crack, it seems that this underground fissure gradually extended upwards to the surface and was narrow at first, as is common with fissures caused by earthquakes. Lava and gases might escape from the point of least resistance along the crack until the initial opening became blocked by eruptions and solidified lava, causing other openings to form in succession along the original fissure. Von Buch observed that each crater was lowest on the side where lava had flowed; however, some craters were intact and had no lava streams. In one of these craters, there were open fissures from which hot steam rose, which in 1815 raised the thermometer to 145° Fahrenheit, likely reaching the boiling point lower down. The emissions seemed to consist of water vapor; nevertheless, they couldn't be pure steam, as the crevices were lined on either side with siliceous sinter (a white, opal-like silica hydrate), which extended nearly to the middle. This significant fact indicates how long chemical processes continue after eruptions and how open fissures can be filled laterally with mineral matter, sublimed from volcanic gases. The lavas from this eruption covered nearly a third of the entire island, often creating large horizontal sheets on gently sloping surfaces, spanning several square leagues, resembling the basaltic platforms of Auvergne.

Pretended distinction between ancient and modern lavas.—One of the new lavas was observed to contain masses of olivine of an olive-green color, resembling those which occur in one of the lavas of the Vivarais. Von Buch supposes the great crystals of olivine to have been derived from a previously existing basalt melted up by the new volcanoes; but we have scarcely sufficient data to bear out such a conjecture. The older rocks of the island consist, in a great measure, of that kind of basaltic lava called dolerite, sometimes columnar, and partly of common basalt and amygdaloid. Some recent lavas assumed, on entering the sea, a prismatic form, and so much resembled the older lavas of the Canaries, that the only geological distinction which Von Buch appears to have been able to draw between them was, that they did not alternate with conglomerates, like the ancient basalts. Some modern writers have endeavored to discover, in the abundance of these conglomerates, a proof of the dissimilarity of the volcanic action in ancient and modern times; but this character is more probably attributable to the difference between submarine operations and those on the land. All the blocks and imperfectly rounded fragments of lava, transported during the intervals of eruption, by rivers and torrents, into the adjoining sea, or torn by the continued action of the waves from cliffs which are undermined, must accumulate in stratified breccias and conglomerates, and be covered again and again by other lavas. This is 439 now taking place on the shores of Sicily, between Catania and Trezza, where the sea breaks down and covers the shore with blocks and pebbles of the modern lavas of Etna; and on parts of the coast of Ischia, where numerous currents of trachyte are in like manner undermined in lofty precipices. So often, then, as an island is raised in a volcanic archipelago by earthquakes from the deep, the fundamental and (relatively to all above) the oldest lava will often be distinguishable from those formed by subsequent eruptions on dry land, by their alternation with beds of sandstone and fragmentary rocks.

Pretended distinction between ancient and modern lavas.—One of the new lavas was found to have chunks of olivine that are olive-green, similar to those seen in one of the lavas from the Vivarais. Von Buch thinks that the large olivine crystals came from an older basalt that was melted by the new volcanoes; however, we don’t have enough evidence to support that idea. The older rocks of the island are mostly made up of a type of basaltic lava called dolerite, which is sometimes columnar, along with regular basalt and amygdaloid. Some recent lavas took on a prismatic shape upon entering the sea and looked so much like the older lavas of the Canaries that the only geological difference Von Buch seemed to find was that they didn’t alternate with conglomerates like the ancient basalts. Some modern writers have tried to prove that the abundance of these conglomerates indicates a difference in volcanic activity between ancient and modern times; but this is more likely due to the difference between underwater processes and those on land. All the blocks and unevenly rounded lava fragments, carried during eruptions by rivers and torrents into the nearby sea or broken off by the relentless action of the waves from eroded cliffs, must pile up in layered breccias and conglomerates, only to be covered repeatedly by other lavas. This is 439 currently happening on the shores of Sicily, between Catania and Trezza, where the sea erodes and deposits the shore with blocks and pebbles from the modern lavas of Etna; and along parts of the coast of Ischia, where many flows of trachyte are similarly undercut by tall cliffs. Thus, whenever an island rises in a volcanic archipelago through earthquakes from below, the base layer, which is generally the oldest lava compared to those formed by later eruptions on dry land, will usually be distinguishable by alternating layers of sandstone and fragmented rocks.

The supposed want of identity, then, between the volcanic phenomena of different epochs resolves itself partly at least into the marked difference between the operations simultaneously in progress, above and below the waters. Such, indeed, is the source, as was before stated in the First Book (Chap. V.), of many of our strongest theoretical prejudices in geology. No sooner do we study and endeavor to explain submarine appearances, than we feel, to use a common expression, out of our element; and unwilling to concede that our extreme ignorance of processes now continually going on can be the cause of our perplexity, we take refuge in a "pre-existent order of nature."

The supposed lack of identity between the volcanic activity from different periods is at least partly due to the significant differences in the processes happening above and below the water at the same time. This, as mentioned previously in the First Book (Chap. V.), is the source of many of our strongest theoretical biases in geology. As soon as we start to study and try to explain underwater phenomena, we feel, to use a common phrase, out of our element; and rather than admitting that our complete ignorance of the ongoing processes is the reason for our confusion, we retreat to the idea of a "pre-existing order of nature."

Recent formation of oolitic travertin in Lancerote.—Throughout a considerable part of Lancerote, the old lavas are covered by a thin stratum of limestone, from an inch to two feet in thickness. It is of a hard stalactitic nature, sometimes oolitic, like the Jura limestone, and contains fragments of lava and terrestrial shells, chiefly helices and spiral bulimi. It sometimes rises to the height of 800 feet above the level of the sea. Von Buch imagines that this remarkable superstratum has been produced by the furious northwest storms, which in winter drive the spray of the sea in clouds over the whole island; from whence calcareous particles may be deposited stalactitically. Mr. Darwin informs me that he found a limestone in St. Helena, the harder parts of which correspond precisely to the stone of Lancerote. He attributes the origin of this rock in St. Helena not to the spray of the sea, but to drifting by violent winds of the finer particles of shells from the sea-beach. Some parts of this drift are subsequently dissolved by atmospheric moisture, and redeposited, so as to convert calcareous sand into oolite.

Recent formation of oolitic travertine in Lanzarote.—Throughout much of Lanzarote, old lava formations are covered by a thin layer of limestone, ranging from an inch to two feet thick. This limestone is hard and stalactitic in nature, sometimes oolitic, similar to the Jura limestone, and contains fragments of lava and land shells, mainly helices and spiral bulimi. It can sometimes reach heights of 800 feet above sea level. Von Buch believes this unique layer was created by fierce northwest storms that, during winter, send clouds of sea spray over the entire island; from which calcareous particles may settle stalactitically. Mr. Darwin informed me that he discovered a limestone in St. Helena, whose harder parts correspond exactly to the stone in Lanzarote. He suggests that the origin of this rock in St. Helena results not from sea spray, but from fine shell particles being blown from the beach by strong winds. Some of this drift is later dissolved by moisture in the atmosphere and redeposited, transforming calcareous sand into oolite.

Recent eruption in Lancerote.—From the year 1736 to 1815, when Von Buch visited Lancerote, there had been no eruption; but, in August, 1824, a crater opened near the port of Rescif, and formed by its ejections, in the space of twenty-four hours, a considerable hill. Violent earthquakes preceded and accompanied this eruption.605

Recent eruption in Lanzarote.—From 1736 to 1815, when Von Buch visited Lanzarote, there had been no eruptions; however, in August 1824, a crater opened near the port of El Reducto, creating a significant hill in just twenty-four hours from its eruptions. Intense earthquakes occurred before and during this eruption.605

Teneriffe.—The Peak of Teneriffe is about 12,000 feet high, and stands, says Von Buch, like a tower encircled by its fosse and bastion. The bastion consists, like the semicircular escarpment of Somma turned towards Vesuvius, of precipitous cliffs, composed of trachyte, basalt, coarse conglomerates, and tuffs, traversed by volcanic dikes, mostly vertical, and of 440 basalt. These cliffs vary in height from 1000 to 1800 feet, and are supposed by Von Buch to have been heaved up into their present position by a force exerted from below, in accordance with the theory proposed by the same author for the origin of the cones of Vesuvius and Etna. According to the observations of M. Deville in 1839606, the trachytes are often granitoid in their aspect, and contain instead of glassy felspar the allied mineral called oligoclase, which had been previously considered as characteristic of more ancient igneous rocks. The same traveller supposes, although he found no limestone or trace of fossils in any of the rocks of Teneriffe, that the alternating trachytes and trachytic conglomerates originated beneath the sea. If this opinion be correct, and it is at least very probable, geologists may still speculate on two modes in which the mass of the island acquired its present form and elevation above the sea. 1st, The advocates of Von Buch's crater-of-elevation hypothesis may imagine that a succession of horizontally superimposed beds were upheaved by a sudden movement, and tilted so as to dip in all directions outwards from the centre of a new dome-shaped eminence, in the middle of which a large opening or bowl-shaped cavity was produced. 2dly, Or according to the theory which to me appears preferable, a submarine hill in the form of a flattened dome may have gradually accumulated, partly below the waters and partly above by the continued outpourings of sheets of lava and the ejection of ashes from a central orifice. In this case the dikes would represent the fissures, which were filled during successive eruptions, and the original inclination of the beds may have been increased by the distension and upheaval of the mass during reiterated convulsions, acting most forcibly at or near the channel of discharge, which would become partially sealed up with lava from time to time, and then be burst open again during eruptions. At length the whole island may have been raised bodily out of the sea by a gradual upward movement.

Tenerife.—The Peak of Tenerife is about 12,000 feet high and stands, according to Von Buch, like a tower surrounded by its ditch and fortifications. The fortifications, similar to the semicircular cliffs of Somma facing Vesuvius, consist of steep cliffs made of trachyte, basalt, coarse conglomerates, and tuffs, intersected by mostly vertical volcanic dikes, primarily basalt. These cliffs range in height from 1,000 to 1,800 feet and are thought by Von Buch to have been pushed into their current position by a force from below, in line with the theory he proposed for the formation of the cones of Vesuvius and Etna. Based on M. Deville's observations in 1839606, the trachytes often appear granitoid and contain oligoclase instead of glassy felspar, a mineral previously thought to be characteristic of older igneous rocks. The same traveler suggests, despite finding no limestone or fossil traces in any of Tenerife's rocks, that the alternating trachytes and trachytic conglomerates formed beneath the sea. If this view is correct, and it seems quite likely, geologists might still consider two ways in which the island's mass attained its current shape and height above the sea. First, proponents of Von Buch's crater-of-elevation hypothesis might envision that a series of horizontally stacked layers were lifted by a sudden movement and tilted to slope outwards from the center of a new dome-shaped peak, where a large opening or bowl-shaped cavity formed. Secondly, or according to the theory I find more convincing, a submarine hill in the shape of a flattened dome could have gradually built up, partly underwater and partly above, through continuous lava flows and ash ejections from a central vent. In this scenario, the dikes would represent the fissures filled during successive eruptions, and the original tilt of the layers may have increased due to the swelling and uplift of the mass during repeated seismic events, acting most strongly at or near the discharge channel, which would occasionally become sealed with lava and then reopened during eruptions. Ultimately, the entire island may have been gradually raised out of the sea through an upward movement.

Whatever theory we adopt, we must always explain the abrupt termination of the dikes and layers of trachyte and basalt in the steep walls of the escarpments surrounding the great crater by supposing the removal of part of the materials once prolonged farther inward towards the centre. If, according to the elevation-crater hypothesis, a series of sheets of lava and ashes originally spread over a level and even surface have been violently broken and uplifted, why do not the opposite walls of the chasm correspond in such a manner as to imply by their present outline that they were formerly united? It is evident that the precipices on opposite sides of the crateriform hollow would not fit if brought together, there being no projecting masses in one wall to enter into indentations in the other, as would happen with the sides of many mineral veins, trap-dikes, and faults, could we extract the intrusive matter now separating them, and reunite the rocks which have been fractured and disjoined.

No matter which theory we choose, we always need to explain why the dikes and layers of trachyte and basalt abruptly end in the steep cliffs around the large crater by assuming that part of the materials once extended further inward toward the center were removed. According to the elevation-crater hypothesis, if a series of sheets of lava and ash originally spread over a flat and even surface have been violently broken and uplifted, why don’t the opposite walls of the chasm line up in a way that suggests they were once connected? It’s clear that the cliffs on opposite sides of the crater wouldn’t fit together if they were brought close, as there are no protruding masses on one side to fit into the indentations on the other, unlike how the sides of many mineral veins, trap-dikes, and faults would align if we could remove the intrusive material currently separating them and bring together the fractured rocks.

The highest crater of the peak has merely disengaged sulphureous 441 vapors ever since it has been known to Europeans; but an eruption happened in June, 1798, not far from the summit, and others are recorded, which poured out streams of lava from great heights, besides many which have broken out nearer the level of the sea. All these, however, seem to be dependent on one great centre of eruption, or on that open channel communicating between the interior of the earth and the atmosphere, which terminates in the highest crater of the peak.

The highest crater of the peak has only released sulfurous 441 vapors since it was first discovered by Europeans; however, there was an eruption in June 1798, not far from the summit, along with others that are recorded, which sent streams of lava flowing from great heights, in addition to many that erupted closer to sea level. All these eruptions, though, seem to be connected to one main center of eruption or to that open channel linking the earth's interior and the atmosphere, which ends in the highest crater of the peak.

We may consider Teneriffe, then, as having been from a remote period the principal and habitual vent of the volcanic archipelago of the Canaries. The discharges which have taken place in the contiguous isles of Palma, Lancerote, and the rest, may be of a subsidiary kind, and have probably been most frequent and violent when the greater crater has been partially sealed up, just as the violent eruptions of Ischia or that of Monte Nuovo coincided with the dormant state of Vesuvius.

We can think of Tenerife as having been the main and constant outlet for the volcanic islands of the Canaries for a long time. The eruptions that have happened on the nearby islands of La Palma, Lanzarote, and others may have been secondary and likely occurred more often and violently when the larger crater was partially blocked, similar to how the intense eruptions of Ischia or Monte Nuovo happened while Vesuvius was inactive.

SANTORIN.

The Gulf of Santorin, in the Grecian Archipelago, has been for two thousand years a scene of active volcanic operations. The largest of the three outer islands of the group (to which the general name of Santorin is given) is called Thera (or sometimes Santorin), and forms more than two-thirds of the circuit of the gulf (see Map, fig. 63, p. 442). The length of the exterior coast-line of this and the other two islands named Therasia and Aspronisi, taken together, amounts to about thirty miles, and that of the inner coast-line of the same islands to about eighteen miles. In the middle of the gulf are three other islands, called the Little, the New, and the Old "Kaimenis," or "Burnt Islands." The accompanying map has been reduced from a recent survey executed in 1848 by Captain Graves, R. N., and shortly to be published by the Admiralty.

The Gulf of Santorini, in the Greek Archipelago, has been a site of active volcanic activity for two thousand years. The largest of the three outer islands in the group, generally referred to as Santorini, is called Thera (or sometimes Santorini) and makes up more than two-thirds of the gulf's perimeter (see Map, fig. 63, p. 442). The total length of the outer coastline of this island and the other two, named Therasia and Aspronisi, is about thirty miles, while the inner coastline of the same islands measures around eighteen miles. In the center of the gulf are three other islands known as the Little, the New, and the Old "Kaimenis," or "Burnt Islands." The map accompanying this text has been scaled down from a recent survey conducted in 1848 by Captain Graves, R. N., and will soon be published by the Admiralty.

Fig. 63.Map of Santorin in the Grecian Archipelago, from a Survey in 1848, by Captain Graves, R. N.

Map of Santorin in the Grecian Archipelago, from a Survey in 1848, by Captain Graves, R. N.
The soundings are given in fathoms.

Map of Santorini in the Greek Archipelago, based on a survey from 1848, by Captain Graves, R. N.
The depths are indicated in fathoms.

A, Shoal formed by submarine volcanic eruption in 1650.
B, Northern entrance.
C, Mansell's Rock.
D, Mount St. Elias, 1887 feet high.

A, Shoal created by an underwater volcanic eruption in 1650.
B, Northern entrance.
C, Mansell's Rock.
D, Mount St. Elias, 1887 feet tall.

Fig. 64.Section of Santorin, in a N. E. and S. W. direction, from Thera through the Kaimenia to Aspronisi.

Section of Santorin, in a N. E. and S. W. direction, from Thera through the Kaimenia to Aspronisi.

Section of Santorini, running in a N.E. and S.W. direction, from Thera through the Kaimenia to Aspronisi.

Fig. 65.>Part of the section, fig. 64, enlarged.

Part of the section, fig. 64, enlarged.

Part of the section, __A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__, expanded.

Pliny informs us that the year 186, B. C., gave birth to the Old Kaimeni, also called Hiera, or the "Sacred Isle," and in the year 19 of our era "Thia" (the Divine) made its appearance above water, and was soon joined by subsequent eruptions to the older island, from which it was only 250 paces distant. The Old Kaimeni also increased successively in size in 726 and in 1427. A century and a half later, in 1573, another eruption produced the cone and crater called Micra-Kaimeni, or "the Small Burnt Island." The next great event which we find recorded occurred in 1650, when a submarine outbreak violently agitated the sea, at a point three and a half miles to the N. E. of Thera, and which gave rise to a shoal (see A in the map) carefully examined during the late survey in 1848 by Captain Graves, and found to have ten fathoms water over it, the sea deepening around it in all directions. This eruption lasted three months, covering the sea with floating pumice. At the same time an earthquake destroyed many houses in Thera, while the sea broke upon the coast and overthrew two churches, exposing to view two villages, one on each side of the mountain of St. Stephen, both of which 443 must have been overwhelmed by showers of volcanic matter during some previous eruptions of unknown date.607 The accompanying evolution of sulphur and hydrogen issuing from the sea killed more than fifty persons, and above 1000 domestic animals. A wave, also, 50 feet high, broke upon the rocks of the Isle of Nia, about four leagues distant, and advanced 450 yards into the interior of the Island of Sikino. Lastly, in 1707 and 1709, Nea-Kaimeni, or the New Burnt Island, was formed between the two others, Palaia and Micra, the Old and Little isles. This isle was composed originally of two distinct parts; the first which rose was called the White Island, composed of a mass of pumice, extremely porous. Gorce, the Jesuit, who was then in Santorin, says that the rock "cut like bread," and that, when the inhabitants landed on it, they found a multitude of full-grown fresh oysters adhering to it, which they ate.608 This mass was afterwards covered, in great part, by the matter ejected from the crater of a twin-island formed simultaneously, and called Black Island, consisting of brown trachyte. The trachytic lava which rose on this spot appears to have been a long time in an intumescent state, for the New Kaimeni was sometimes lowered on one side while it gained height on the other, and rocks rose up in the sea at different distances from the shore and then disappeared again. The eruption was renewed at intervals during the years 1711 and 1712, and at length a cone was piled up to the height of 330 feet above the level of the sea, its exterior slope forming an angle of 33° with the horizon, and the crater on its summit being 80 yards in diameter. In addition to the two points of subaerial eruption on the New and Little Kaimenis, two other cones, indicating the sites of submarine outbursts of unknown date, were discovered under water near the Kaimenis during the late survey.

Pliny tells us that in 186 B.C., the Old Kaimeni was formed, also known as Hiera, or the "Sacred Isle." Then, in 19 A.D., "Thia" (the Divine) emerged from the sea and was soon connected by later eruptions to the older island, which was only 250 paces away. The Old Kaimeni also gradually grew larger in 726 and 1427. A century and a half later, in 1573, another eruption created the cone and crater called Micra-Kaimeni, or "the Small Burnt Island." The next significant event recorded happened in 1650, when a submarine eruption violently disturbed the sea about three and a half miles northeast of Thera, creating a shoal (see A on the map) that was thoroughly examined during the 1848 survey by Captain Graves, who found it had ten fathoms of water over it, with the sea deepening around it in all directions. This eruption lasted for three months, covering the sea with floating pumice. At the same time, an earthquake destroyed many buildings in Thera, and the sea crashed against the shore, toppling two churches and revealing two villages, one on each side of St. Stephen’s Mountain, both of which must have been buried under volcanic debris during previous eruptions of unknown dates. The release of sulfur and hydrogen from the sea resulted in the deaths of more than fifty people and over a thousand livestock. Additionally, a wave 50 feet high crashed against the rocks of Nia Island, around four leagues away, and pushed 450 yards into the interior of Sikino Island. Finally, in 1707 and 1709, Nea-Kaimeni, or the New Burnt Island, formed between the other two islands, Palaia and Micra. This island originally consisted of two distinct areas; the first to rise was known as the White Island, made up of a highly porous mass of pumice. Gorce, the Jesuit who was in Santorin at the time, noted that the rock "cut like bread," and when locals landed on it, they found numerous full-grown fresh oysters attached, which they ate. This mass was later mostly covered by material expelled from a concurrently formed twin island called Black Island, made of brown trachyte. The trachytic lava that emerged in this area seemed to spend a long time in an expanded state, as the New Kaimeni would sometimes sink on one side while rising on the other, with rocks appearing and disappearing in the sea at varying distances from the shore. Eruptions resumed intermittently in 1711 and 1712, eventually forming a cone that reached 330 feet above sea level, with the outside slope angled at 33° relative to the horizon, and the crater at its peak measuring 80 yards in diameter. Besides the two points of eruption on the New and Little Kaimenis, two other cones, indicating sites of earlier underwater eruptions of unknown dates, were found beneath the water near the Kaimenis during the recent survey.

In regard to the "White Island," which was described and visited by Gorce in 1707, we are indebted to Mr. Edward Forbes for having, in 1842, carefully investigated the layer of pumiceous ash of which it is constituted. He obtained from it many shells of marine genera, Pectunculus, Arca, Cardita, Trochus, and others, both univalve and bivalve, all of recent Mediterranean species. They were in a fine state of preservation, the bivalves with the epidermis remaining, and valves closed, showing that they had been suddenly destroyed. Mr. Forbes, from his study of the habits of the mollusca living at different depths in the Mediterranean, was able to decide that such an assemblage of species could not have lived at a less depth than 220 feet, so that a bodily upheaval of the mass to that amount must have taken place in order to bring up this bed of ashes and shells to the level of the sea, and they now rise five or six feet above that level.609

Regarding "White Island," which Gorce described and visited in 1707, we owe thanks to Mr. Edward Forbes for his careful investigation of the layer of pumiceous ash that makes it up in 1842. He collected many shells of marine genera, including Pectunculus, Arca, Cardita, Trochus, and others, both univalve and bivalve, all from recent Mediterranean species. They were well-preserved, with the bivalves' outer layer intact and valves closed, indicating that they had been suddenly destroyed. Mr. Forbes, through his study of the habits of mollusks living at varying depths in the Mediterranean, concluded that this group of species could not have lived at less than 220 feet deep. This means there must have been a significant uplift of the mass to that extent to raise this layer of ash and shells to sea level, which now sits five or six feet above that level.609

We may compare this partial elevation of solid matter to the rise of a hardened crust of scoriæ, such as is usually formed on the surface of lava-currents, even while they are in motion, and which, although stony and capable of supporting heavy weights, may be upraised without 444 bursting by the intumescence of the melted matter below. That the upheaval was merely local is proved by the fact that the neighboring Kaimenis did not participate in the movement, still less the three more distant or outer islands before mentioned. The history, therefore, of the Kaimenis shows that they have been the result of intermittent action, and it lends no support to the hypothesis of the sudden distension of horizontal beds blown up like a bladder by a single paroxysmal effort of expansive gases.

We can liken this slight rise of solid material to the formation of a hardened layer of scoria, which typically develops on the surface of lava flows, even while they are still moving. This layer, although rocky and able to bear heavy loads, can be lifted without 444 cracking due to the swelling of the molten material underneath. The fact that the nearby Kaimenis did not experience this movement, nor did the three even more distant outer islands mentioned earlier, proves that the upheaval was strictly local. Therefore, the history of the Kaimenis indicates they resulted from intermittent activity and does not support the idea that a sudden inflation of horizontal layers occurred, like a balloon being inflated by a single explosive release of gas.

It will be seen by the accompanying map and sections, that the Kaimenis are arranged in a linear direction, running N. E. and S. W., in a manner different from that represented in the older charts. In their longest diameter they form at their base a ridge nearly bisecting the gulf or crater (see sections, figs. 64, 65).

It can be observed from the accompanying map and sections that the Kaimenis are aligned in a straight line, running northeast to southwest, which differs from what is shown in the older charts. In their longest diameter, they create a ridge at their base that almost divides the gulf or crater (see sections, figs. 64, 65).

On considering these facts we are naturally led to compare the smaller and newer islands in the centre of the gulf to the modern cone of Vesuvius, surrounded by the older semicircular escarpment of Somma, or to liken them to the Peak of Teneriffe before described, as surrounded by its "fosse and bastion." This idea will appear to be still more fully confirmed when we study the soundings taken during the late hydrographical survey. Thera, which constitutes alone more than two-thirds of the outer circuit, presents everywhere towards the gulf, high and steep precipices composed of rocks of volcanic origin. In all places near the base of its cliffs, a depth of from 800 to 1000 feet of water was found, and Lieut. Leycester informs us610 that if the gulf, which is six miles in diameter, could be drained, a bowl-shaped cavity would appear with walls 2449 feet high in some places, and even on the southwest side, where it is lowest, nowhere less than 1200 feet high; while the Kaimenis would be seen to form in the centre a huge mountain five and a half miles in circumference at its base, with three principal summits (the Old, the New, and the Little Burnt Islands) rising severally to the heights of 1251, 1629, and 1158 feet above the bottom of the abyss. The rim of the great caldron thus exposed would be observed to be in all parts perfect and unbroken, except at one point where there is a deep and long chasm or channel, known by mariners as "the northern entrance" (B, fig. 63) between Thera and Therasia, and called by Lieut. Leycester "the door into the crater." It is no less than 1170 feet deep, and constitutes, as will appear by the soundings (see map), a remarkable feature in the bed of the sea. There is no corresponding channel passing out from the gulf into the Mediterranean at any other point in the circuit between the outer islands, the greatest depth there ranging from 7 to 66 feet.

On considering these facts, we naturally compare the smaller and newer islands in the center of the gulf to the modern cone of Vesuvius, surrounded by the older semicircular escarpment of Somma, or liken them to the Peak of Tenerife as described earlier, which is surrounded by its "fosse and bastion." This idea becomes even clearer when we examine the soundings taken during the recent hydrographical survey. Thera, which makes up more than two-thirds of the outer circuit, has high and steep cliffs made of volcanic rock that rise sharply toward the gulf. Near the base of its cliffs, depths of 800 to 1,000 feet of water were recorded, and Lieut. Leycester informs us610 that if the gulf, which is six miles in diameter, were drained, a bowl-shaped cavity would emerge with walls reaching 2,449 feet high in some areas; even on the southwestern side, where it’s lowest, the walls are no less than 1,200 feet high. In the center, Kaimenis would reveal a huge mountain with a base circumference of five and a half miles, featuring three main summits (the Old, the New, and the Little Burnt Islands) rising to heights of 1,251, 1,629, and 1,158 feet above the abyss's bottom. The rim of the great caldron thus revealed would be observed to be intact and unbroken, except at one point where there is a deep, long chasm or channel, known by mariners as "the northern entrance" (B, fig. 63) between Thera and Therasia, which Lieut. Leycester refers to as "the door into the crater." This chasm is 1,170 feet deep and is a remarkable feature on the sea floor, as will be evident from the soundings (see map). No corresponding channel leads out from the gulf into the Mediterranean anywhere else in the circuit between the outer islands, where the greatest depth ranges from 7 to 66 feet.

We may conceive, therefore, if at some former time the whole mass of Santorin stood at a higher level by 1200 feet, that this single ravine or narrow valley now forming "the northern entrance," was the passage by which the sea entered a circular bay and swept out in the form of 445 mud and pebbles, the materials derived by denudation from wasting cliffs. In this manner the original crater may have been slowly widened and deepened, after which the whole archipelago may have been partially submerged to its present depth.

We can imagine that, at some point in the past, the entire mass of Santorin was 1200 feet higher. This single ravine or narrow valley, now called "the northern entrance," was likely the passage through which the sea flowed into a circular bay, carrying out mud and pebbles—materials eroded from the cliffs. This process may have gradually expanded and deepened the original crater, after which the entire archipelago may have been partially submerged to its current depth.

That such oscillations of level may in the course of ages have taken place, will be the more readily admitted when we state that part of Thera has actually sunk down in modern times, as, for example, during the great earthquake before alluded to, which happened in 1650. The subsidence alluded to is proved not only by tradition, but by the fact that a road which formerly led between two places on the east coast of Thera is now twelve fathoms under water.

That level changes may have occurred over the ages will be more easily accepted when we point out that part of Thera has actually sunk in modern times, such as during the significant earthquake mentioned earlier, which took place in 1650. This subsidence is supported not only by local stories but also by the fact that a road that used to connect two locations on the east coast of Thera is now twelve fathoms underwater.

MM. Boblaye and Virlet mention,611 that the waves are constantly undermining and encroaching on the cliffs of Therasia and Aspronisi, and shoals or submarine ledges were found, during the late survey, to occur round a great part of these islands, attesting the recent progress of denudation. M. Virlet also remarks, in regard to the separation of the three islands forming the walls of the crater, that the channels between them are all to the W. and N. W., the quarter most exposed to the waves and currents.

MM. Boblaye and Virlet mention,611 that the waves are constantly eroding and encroaching on the cliffs of Therasia and Aspronisi, and during the recent survey, underwater shoals or ledges were discovered around much of these islands, indicating the ongoing process of erosion. M. Virlet also notes concerning the separation of the three islands that form the walls of the crater, that the channels between them all lie to the west and northwest, the directions most exposed to the waves and currents.

Mr. Darwin, in his work on volcanic islands, has shown that in the Mauritius and in Santiago, there is an external circle of basaltic rocks of vast diameter, in the interior of which more modern eruptions have taken place, the older rocks dipping away from the central space in every direction, as in the outer islands of Santorin. He refers the numerous breaches, some of them very wide in the external ramparts of those islands, to the denuding action of the sea. Every geologist, therefore, will be prepared to call in the aid of the same powerful cause, to account for the removal of a large part of the rocks which must once have occupied the interior space, in the same manner as they attribute the abstraction of matter from elliptical "valleys of elevation," such as those of Woolhope and the Wealden in England, to the waves and currents of the sea.

Mr. Darwin, in his work on volcanic islands, has shown that in Mauritius and Santiago, there is an outer circle of basalt rocks of enormous size, inside of which more recent eruptions have occurred. The older rocks slope away from the center in all directions, similar to the outer islands of Santorin. He attributes the many gaps, some quite large, in the outer walls of those islands to the eroding effects of the sea. Therefore, every geologist will be prepared to use the same powerful force to explain the removal of a large portion of the rocks that must have once filled the interior space, just as they attribute the loss of material from elliptical "valleys of elevation," like those of Woolhope and the Wealden in England, to the waves and currents of the sea.

Thera, Therasia, and Aspronisi are all composed of volcanic matter, except the southern part of Thera, where Mount St. Elias rises to three times the height of the loftiest of the igneous rocks, reaching an elevation of 1887 feet above the sea.612 This mountain is formed of granular limestone and argillaceous schist, and must have been originally a submarine eminence in the bed of the Mediterranean, before the volcanic cone, one side of the base of which now abuts against it, was formed. The inclination, strike, and fractures of the calcareous and argillaceous strata of St. Elias have no relation to the great cone, but, according to M. Bory St. Vincent, have the same direction as those of the other isles of the Grecian Archipelago, namely, from N. N. W. to S. S. E. Each of the three islands, Thera, Therasia, and Aspronisi, 446 is capped by an enormous mass of white tufaceous conglomerate, from forty to fifty feet thick, beneath which are beds of trachytic lava and tuff, having a gentle inclination of only 3° or 4°. Each bed is usually very narrow and discontinuous, the successive layers being moulded or dove-tailed, as M. Virlet expresses it, into the inequalities of the previously existing surface, on which showers of cinders or streams of melted matter have been poured. Nothing, therefore, seems more evident than that we have in Santorin the basal remains of a great ruined cone, or flattened dome; and the absence of dikes in the cliffs surrounding the gulf would indicate that the eruptions took place originally, as they have done in the last two thousand years, not near the margin but in the centre of the space now occupied by the gulf. The central portions of the dome have since been removed by engulfment, or denudation, or by both these causes.

Thera, Therasia, and Aspronisi are all made of volcanic materials, except for the southern part of Thera, where Mount St. Elias rises to three times the height of the tallest igneous rocks, reaching an elevation of 1,887 feet above sea level.612 This mountain is made of granular limestone and clay schist, and must have originally been an underwater peak in the Mediterranean before the volcanic cone, one side of which now touches it, was formed. The tilt, direction, and cracks of the limestone and clay layers of St. Elias don't relate to the large cone, but, according to M. Bory St. Vincent, they are oriented the same way as those of the other islands in the Greek Archipelago, specifically from N. N. W. to S. S. E. Each of the three islands, Thera, Therasia, and Aspronisi, 446 is topped by a massive layer of white tuff conglomerate that is about forty to fifty feet thick, beneath which are layers of trachytic lava and tuff, sloping gently at only 3° or 4°. Each layer is generally quite narrow and disconnected, with successive layers fitting or interlocking, as M. Virlet describes it, into the uneven surface that was there before, where showers of ash or flows of molten material have been deposited. Therefore, it seems clear that Santorin contains the remaining base of a large destroyed cone or flattened dome; and the lack of dikes in the cliffs surrounding the gulf suggests that the eruptions originally occurred, as they have in the last two thousand years, not close to the edge but in the center of the area currently filled by the gulf. The central parts of the dome have since been removed due to engulfment, erosion, or both of these factors.

An important fact is adduced by M. Virlet, to show that the gentle dip of the lava-streams in the three outer islands towards all points of the compass, away from the centre of the gulf, has not been due to the upheaval of horizontal beds, as conjectured by Von Buch, who had not visited Santorin.613 The French geologist found that the vesicles or pores of the trachytic masses were lengthened out in the several directions in which they would have flowed if they had descended from the axis of a cone once occupying the centre of the crater. For it is well known that the bubbles of confined gas in a fluid in motion assume an oval form, and the direction of their longer axis coincides always with that of the stream.

An important fact is presented by M. Virlet to demonstrate that the gentle slope of the lava flows in the three outer islands towards all points of the compass, away from the center of the gulf, is not due to the uplift of horizontal layers, as suggested by Von Buch, who had not visited Santorin.613 The French geologist discovered that the vesicles or pores in the trachytic masses were elongated in the different directions they would have flowed if they had come down from the center of a cone that once occupied the center of the crater. It's well known that gas bubbles trapped in a moving fluid take on an oval shape, and the direction of their longer axis always aligns with the flow of the stream.

On a review, therefore, of all the facts now brought to light respecting Santorin, I attribute the moderate slope of the beds in Thera and the other external islands to their having originally descended the inclined flanks of a large volcanic cone, the principal orifice or vents of eruption having been always situated where they are now, in or near the centre of the space occupied by the gulf or crater—in other words, where the outburst of the Kaimenis has been witnessed in historical times. The single long and deep opening into the crater is a feature common to all those remnants of ancient volcanoes, the central portions of which have been removed, and is probably connected with aqueous denudation. This denuding process has been the work of ages when the sea was admitted into an original crater, and has taken place during the gradual emergence of the island from the sea, or during various oscillations in its level.

On reviewing all the facts uncovered about Santorin, I believe the gentle slope of the layers in Thera and the other outer islands is because they originally sloped down the inclined sides of a large volcanic cone. The main opening or vents for eruptions have always been located where they are now, in or near the center of the area occupied by the gulf or crater—in other words, where the eruptions of the Kaimenis have been observed in historical times. The single long and deep opening into the crater is a characteristic of all those remnants of ancient volcanoes whose central parts have been eroded away, and it is likely linked to water erosion. This erosion process has occurred over ages when the sea entered the original crater and has taken place during the gradual rise of the island from the sea, or during various fluctuations in its level.

The volcanic island of St. Paul in the midst of the Indian Ocean, lat. 38° 44' S., long. 77° 37' E., surveyed by Capt. Blackwood in 1842, seems to exemplify the first stage in the formation of such an archipelago as that of Santorin. We have there a crater one mile in diameter, surrounded by steep and lofty cliffs on every side save one, where the sea enters by a single passage nearly dry at low water. In the interior of 447 the small circular bay or crater there is a depth of 30 fathoms, or 180 feet. The surface of the island slopes away on all sides from the crest of the rocks encircling the crater.614

The volcanic island of St. Paul, located in the Indian Ocean at latitude 38° 44' S and longitude 77° 37' E, was surveyed by Captain Blackwood in 1842. It appears to represent the initial stage in forming an archipelago like Santorin. The island features a crater that is one mile wide, surrounded by steep, high cliffs on all sides except for one, where the sea enters through a single passage that is nearly dry at low tide. Inside the small circular bay or crater, the depth reaches 30 fathoms, or 180 feet. The island's surface slopes downwards from the rim of the rocks that encircle the crater.447 614

Fig. 66.Cone and crater of Barren Island.

Cone and crater of Barren Island, in the Bay of Bengal. Height of the central cone (according to Capt Miller, in 1834), 500 feet.

Cone and crater of Barren Island, in the Bay of Bengal. Height of the central cone (according to Capt Miller, in 1834), 500 feet.

Barren Island.—There is great analogy between the structure of Barren Island in the Bay of Bengal, lat. 12° 15', and that of Santorin last described. When seen from the ocean, this island presents, on almost all sides, a surface of bare rocks, rising, with a moderate acclivity, towards the interior; but at one point there is a cleft by which we can penetrate into the centre, and there discover that it is occupied by a great circular basin, filled by the waters of the sea, and bordered all around by steep rocks, in the midst of which rises a volcanic cone, very frequently in eruption. The summit of this cone is about 500 feet in height, corresponding to that of the circular border which incloses the basin; so that it can be seen from the sea only through the ravine. It is most probable that the exterior inclosure of Barren Island (c, d, fig. 67) is nothing more than the remains of a truncated cone c, a, b, d, a great portion of which has been removed by engulfment, explosion, or denudation, which may have preceded the formation of the new interior cone, f, e, g.615

Barren Island.—There's a strong comparison to be made between the structure of Barren Island in the Bay of Bengal at latitude 12° 15' and that of Santorin described earlier. From the ocean, this island shows mostly bare rocks rising gently towards the interior; however, there’s a gap that allows access to the center, where you'll find a large circular basin filled with sea water and surrounded by steep cliffs. In the middle of this basin is a volcanic cone that frequently erupts. The top of this cone stands about 500 feet high, matching the height of the circular edge surrounding the basin, so it can only be seen from the sea through the ravine. It's highly likely that the outer border of Barren Island (c, d, fig. 67) is simply the remnants of a truncated cone c, a, b, d, much of which has been removed due to collapse, explosion, or erosion that may have happened before the new inner cone formed, f, e, g.615

Fig. 67.Supposed section of Barren Island,

Supposed section of Barren Island, in the Bay of Bengal.

Supposed section of Barren Island, in the Bay of Bengal.

MUD VOLCANOES.

Iceland.—Mr. R. Bunsen, in his account of the pseudo-volcanic phenomena of Iceland, describes many valleys where sulphurous and aqueous vapors burst forth with a hissing sound, from the hot soil 448 formed of volcanic tuff. In such spots a pool of boiling water is seen, in which a bluish-black argillaceous paste rises in huge bubbles. These bubbles on bursting throw the boiling mud to a height of fifteen feet and upwards, accumulating it in ledges round the crater or basin of the spring.

Iceland.—Mr. R. Bunsen, in his account of the volcanic features of Iceland, describes many valleys where sulfurous and watery vapors erupt with a hissing sound from the hot ground made of volcanic tuff. In these areas, a pool of boiling water is visible, in which a bluish-black clay-like substance rises in large bubbles. When these bubbles burst, they splash the boiling mud up to fifteen feet or more, piling it up in ledges around the crater or basin of the spring. 448

Baku on the Caspian.—The formation of a new mud volcano was witnessed on the 27th of November, 1827, at Tokmali, on the peninsula of Abscheron, east of Baku. Flames blazed up to an extraordinary height for a space of three hours, and continued for twenty hours to rise about three feet above a crater, from which mud was ejected. At another point in the same district where flames issued, fragments of rock of large size were hurled up into the air, and scattered around.616

Baku on the Caspian.—On November 27, 1827, a new mud volcano appeared at Tokmali, on the Abscheron peninsula, east of Baku. Flames shot up to an incredible height for three hours and continued to rise about three feet above the crater for another twenty hours, ejecting mud. At a different spot in the same area where flames erupted, large chunks of rock were thrown into the air and scattered around.616

Fig. 68.Mud cones and craters of Hinglaj.

Mud cones and craters of Hinglaj near Beila, district of Lus, 120 miles northwest of mouth of Indus. From original drawing by Capt. Robertson. (See Map, p. 460.)

Mud cones and craters of Hinglaj near Beila, in the district of Lus, 120 miles northwest of the Indus River's mouth. From the original drawing by Capt. Robertson. (See Map, p. 460.)

Sicily.—At a place called Macaluba, near Girgenti in Sicily, are several conical mounds from ten to thirty feet in height, with small craters at their summits, from which cold water, mixed with mud and bitumen, is cast out. Bubbles of carbonic acid and carburetted hydrogen gas are also disengaged from these springs, and at certain periods with such violence, as to throw the mud to the height of 200 feet. These "air volcanoes," as they are sometimes termed, are known to have been in the same state of activity for the last fifteen centuries; and Dr. Daubeny imagines that the gases which escape may be generated 449 by the slow combustion of beds of sulphur, which is actually in progress in the blue clay, out of which the springs rise.617 But as the gases are similar to those disengaged in volcanic eruptions, and as they have continued to stream out for so long a period, they may perhaps be derived from a more deep-seated source.

Sicily.—In a place called Macaluba, near Girgenti in Sicily, there are several conical mounds that range from ten to thirty feet tall, each topped with small craters that spew out cold water mixed with mud and bitumen. Bubbles of carbon dioxide and hydrogen gas also escape from these springs, sometimes with such force that they launch mud up to 200 feet into the air. These "air volcanoes," as they are sometimes called, have been actively bubbling for the last fifteen centuries; Dr. Daubeny theorizes that the escaping gases may be produced by the slow burning of sulfur deposits occurring in the blue clay from which the springs emerge. 449 But since the gases are similar to those released during volcanic eruptions, and since they've been escaping for such an extended time, they might originate from a deeper source.

Beila in India.—In the district of Luss or Lus, south of Beila, about 120 miles N. W. of Cutch and the mouths of the Indus (see Map, fig. 71, p. 460), numerous mud volcanoes are scattered over an area of probably not less than 1000 square miles. Some of these have been well described by Captain Hart, and subsequently by Captain Robertson, who has paid a visit to that region, and made sketches of them, which he has kindly placed at my disposal. From one of these the annexed view has been selected. These conical hills occur to the westward of the Hara mountains and the river Hubb. (See Map, p. 460.) One of the cones is 400 feet high, composed of light-colored earth, and having at its summit a crater thirty yards in diameter. The liquid mud which fills the crater is continually disturbed by air-bubbles, and here and there is cast up in small jets.618

Beila in India.—In the district of Luss or Lus, located south of Beila, about 120 miles northwest of Cutch and the mouths of the Indus (see Map, fig. 71, p. 460), there are many mud volcanoes spread over an area of at least 1000 square miles. Some of these have been described in detail by Captain Hart, and later by Captain Robertson, who visited the area and made sketches that he generously shared with me. One of these sketches has been used for the view presented here. These conical hills are found to the west of the Hara mountains and the river Hubb. (See Map, p. 460.) One of the cones stands 400 feet tall, made of light-colored earth, and has a crater at its peak that measures thirty yards across. The liquid mud inside the crater is constantly disturbed by air bubbles, and occasionally it bursts forth in small jets.618

Mineral composition of volcanic products.—The mineral called felspar forms in general more than half of the mass of modern lavas. When it is in great excess, lavas are called trachytic: they consist generally of a base of compact felspar, in which crystals of glassy felspar are disseminated.619 When augite (or pyroxene) predominates, lavas are termed basaltic. They contain about 50 per cent. of silica, or much less than the trachytes, in which there is usually about 75 per cent. of that mineral. They also contain about 11 per cent. of protoxide of iron, and as much of lime, both of which are wanting, or only in insignificant quantities in the trachytic rocks.620 But lavas occur of an intermediate composition between the trachytic and basaltic, which from their color have been called graystones. The abundance of quartz, forming distinct crystals or concretions, characterizes the granitic and other ancient rocks, now generally considered by geologists as of igneous origin; whereas that mineral is rarely exhibited in a separate form in recent lavas, although silica enters so largely into their composition. Hornblende, so common in hypogene rocks, or those commonly called "primary," is rare in modern lava; nor does it enter largely into rocks of any age in which augite abounds. It should, however, be stated, that the experiments of Mr. Gustav Rose have made it very questionable, whether the minerals called hornblende and augite can be separated as distinct species, as their different varieties seem to pass into each other, whether we consider the characters derived from their angles of crystallization, their chemical composition, or their specific gravity. The difference in form of the two substances may be explained by the different circumstances under which 450 they have been produced, the form of hornblende being the result of slower cooling. Crystals of augite have been met with in the scoriæ of furnaces, but never those of hornblende; and crystals of augite have been obtained by melting hornblende in a platina crucible; but hornblende itself has not been formed artificially.621 Mica occurs plentifully in some recent trachytes, but is rarely present where augite is in excess.

Mineral composition of volcanic products.—The mineral felspar generally makes up more than half of the mass of modern lavas. When it is present in large amounts, the lavas are referred to as trachytic; they typically consist of a base of compact felspar with disseminated crystals of glassy felspar.619 When augite (or pyroxene) is dominant, the lavas are called basaltic. They contain about 50 percent silica, which is much less than the approximately 75 percent found in trachytes. They also have around 11 percent iron oxide and the same amount of lime, both of which are either absent or present in very small quantities in trachytic rocks.620 However, there are lavas with a composition that falls between trachytic and basaltic, which have been termed graystones due to their color. The presence of quartz, which forms distinct crystals or concretions, characterizes granitic and other ancient rocks, which are now generally recognized by geologists as of igneous origin; in contrast, quartz is rarely found as a separate form in recent lavas, even though silica is a significant part of their composition. Hornblende, which is common in hypogene rocks, or those known as "primary," is rare in modern lava; it also does not make up a large part of rocks of any age where augite is plentiful. It should be noted that experiments by Mr. Gustav Rose have cast doubt on whether the minerals known as hornblende and augite can be considered distinct species, as their various forms seem to blend into one another whether we look at the characteristics from their angles of crystallization, chemical composition, or specific gravity. The difference in shape of the two substances can be attributed to the different conditions under which they were formed, with hornblende's shape resulting from slower cooling. Augite crystals have been found in furnace scoria, but never hornblende crystals; and augite crystals can be created by melting hornblende in a platinum crucible, but hornblende itself has not been artificially formed.621 Mica is abundant in some recent trachytes but is rarely found where augite is in excess.

Frequency of eruptions, and nature of subterranean igneous rocks.—When we speak of the igneous rocks of our own times, we mean that small portion which, in violent eruptions, is forced up by elastic fluids to the surface of the earth,—the sand, scoriæ, and lava, which cool in the open air. But we cannot obtain access to that which is congealed far beneath the surface under great pressure, equal to that of many hundred, or many thousand atmospheres.

Frequency of eruptions, and nature of subterranean igneous rocks.—When we talk about the igneous rocks of our time, we're referring to that small section which is propelled to the earth's surface by pressurized gases during violent eruptions—the sand, scoria, and lava that cool down in the open air. However, we can't reach the material that's solidified deep underground under immense pressure, equivalent to many hundreds or even thousands of atmospheres.

During the last century, about fifty eruptions are recorded of the five European volcanic districts, of Vesuvius, Etna, Volcano, Santorin, and Iceland; but many beneath the sea in the Grecian archipelago and near Iceland may doubtless have passed unnoticed. If some of them produced no lava, others, on the contrary, like that of Skaptár Jokul, in 1783, poured out melted matter for five or six years consecutively; which cases, being reckoned as single eruptions, will compensate for those of inferior strength. Now, if we consider the active volcanoes of Europe to constitute about a fortieth part of those already known on the globe, and calculate that, one with another, they are about equal in activity to the burning mountains in other districts, we may then compute that there happen on the earth about 2000 eruptions in the course of a century, or about twenty every year.

During the last century, about fifty eruptions have been recorded from the five European volcanic areas: Vesuvius, Etna, Volcano, Santorini, and Iceland; however, many eruptions beneath the sea in the Greek archipelago and near Iceland likely went unnoticed. While some of these eruptions produced no lava, others, like the one from Skaptár Jokul in 1783, released molten material for five or six consecutive years; these cases, counted as single eruptions, will balance out those of lesser intensity. If we consider the active volcanoes in Europe to represent about one-fortieth of all the known volcanoes on the planet, and assume that, on average, they are equally active as volcanoes in other regions, we can estimate that there are about 2,000 eruptions on Earth every century, or around twenty each year.

However inconsiderable, therefore, may be the superficial rocks which the operations of fire produce on the surface, we must suppose the subterranean changes now constantly in progress to be on the grandest scale. The loftiest volcanic cones must be as insignificant, when contrasted to the products of fire in the nether regions, as are the deposits formed in shallow estuaries when compared to submarine formations accumulating in the abysses of the ocean. In regard to the characters of these volcanic rocks, formed in our own times in the bowels of the earth, whether in rents and caverns, or by the cooling of lakes of melted lava, we may safely infer that the rocks are heavier and less porous than ordinary lavas, and more crystalline, although composed of the same mineral ingredients. As the hardest crystals produced artificially in the laboratory require the longest time for their formation, so we must suppose that where the cooling down of melted matter takes place by insensible degrees, in the course of ages, a variety of minerals will be produced far harder than any formed by natural processes within the short period of human observation.

No matter how small the superficial rocks produced by volcanic activity may seem, we can assume that the underground changes happening all the time are on a massive scale. The tallest volcanic cones are insignificant compared to the products of fire below the surface, just like the deposits in shallow estuaries pale in comparison to the formations accumulating in the depths of the ocean. Regarding the characteristics of these volcanic rocks formed in our time deep within the Earth, whether in cracks and caves or from the cooling of lakes of molten lava, we can reasonably conclude that these rocks are heavier and less porous than regular lavas and more crystalline, despite being made of the same minerals. Just as the hardest crystals created artificially in a lab take the longest to form, we can assume that where melted material cools gradually over ages, a variety of minerals will form that are much harder than any created by natural processes during the brief span of human observation.

These subterranean volcanic rocks, moreover, cannot be stratified in the same manner as sedimentary deposits from water, although it is evident that when great masses consolidate from a state of fusion, they may 451 separate into natural divisions; for this is seen to be the case in many lava-currents. We may also expect that the rocks in question will often be rent by earthquakes, since these are common in volcanic regions; and the fissures will be often injected with similar matter, so that dikes of crystalline rock will traverse masses of similar composition. It is also clear, that no organic remains can be included in such masses, as also that these deep-seated igneous formations considered in mass must underlie all the strata containing organic remains, because the heat proceeds from below upwards, and the intensity required to reduce the mineral ingredients to a fluid state must destroy all organic bodies in rocks included in the midst of them.

These underground volcanic rocks can't be layered like sedimentary deposits from water, even though it's clear that when large amounts solidify from a molten state, they can separate into natural divisions; this is seen in many lava flows. We can also expect that these rocks will often be cracked by earthquakes, since those are common in volcanic areas, and the cracks will often be filled with similar material, resulting in dikes of crystalline rock cutting through masses of a similar composition. It's also obvious that no organic remains can be found in these masses, and these deep-seated igneous formations must lie beneath all the layers that contain organic remains because the heat rises from below, and the intensity needed to melt the mineral components would destroy any organic materials in rocks contained within them.

If by a continued series of elevatory movements, such masses shall hereafter be brought up to the surface, in the same manner as sedimentary marine strata have, in the course of ages, been upheaved to the summit of the loftiest mountains, it is not difficult to foresee what perplexing problems may be presented to the geologist. He may then, perhaps, study in some mountain-chain the very rocks produced at the depth of several miles beneath the Andes, Iceland, or Java, in the time of Leibnitz, and draw from them the same conclusion which that philosopher derived from certain igneous products of high antiquity; for he conceived our globe to have been, for an indefinite period, in the state of a comet, without an ocean, and uninhabitable alike by aquatic or terrestrial animals.

If a series of uplifting movements continues, these large masses might eventually be brought to the surface, just like sedimentary marine layers have been pushed up to the tops of the highest mountains over time. It’s not hard to predict the tricky problems that might arise for geologists. They could then study some mountain range and find rocks that formed several miles beneath places like the Andes, Iceland, or Java, back when Leibnitz was around, and come to the same conclusions that he did from ancient volcanic rocks; he believed that our planet was in a comet-like state for an indefinite period, lacking an ocean and uninhabitable by both aquatic and land animals.


CHAPTER XXVII.

EARTHQUAKES AND THEIR EFFECTS.

Earthquakes and their effects—Deficiency of ancient accounts—Ordinary atmospheric phenomena—Changes produced by earthquakes in modern times considered in chronological order—Earthquake in Syria, 1837—Earthquakes in Chili in 1837 and 1835—Isle of Santa Maria raised ten feet—Chili, 1822—Extent of country elevated—Aleppo and Ionian Isles—Earthquake of Cutch in 1819—Subsidence in the Delta of the Indus—Island of Sumbawa in 1815—Earthquake of Caraccas in 1812—Shocks at New Madrid in 1811 in the valley of the Mississippi—Aleutian Islands in 1806—Reflections on the earthquakes of the nineteenth century—Earthquake in Quito, Quebec, &c.—Java, 1786—Sinking down of large tracts.

Earthquakes and their effects—Lack of ancient records—Common weather phenomena—Changes caused by earthquakes in recent times looked at chronologically—Earthquake in Syria, 1837—Earthquakes in Chile in 1837 and 1835—Isle of Santa Maria lifted ten feet—Chile, 1822—Scale of land raised—Aleppo and the Ionian Islands—Earthquake in Cutch in 1819—Land sinking in the Delta of the Indus—Island of Sumbawa in 1815—Earthquake in Caracas in 1812—Shocks at New Madrid in 1811 in the Mississippi Valley—Aleutian Islands in 1806—Thoughts on the earthquakes of the nineteenth century—Earthquake in Quito, Quebec, etc.—Java, 1786—Large areas sinking.

In the sketch before given of the geographical boundaries of volcanic regions, I stated, that although the points of eruption are but thinly scattered, constituting mere spots on the surface of those vast districts, yet the subterranean movements extend simultaneously over immense areas. We may now proceed to consider the changes which these movements produce on the surface, and in the internal structure of the earth's crust.

In the earlier sketch of the geographical boundaries of volcanic regions, I mentioned that even though the eruption points are sparse, representing just small spots on the surface of those large areas, the underground movements spread out simultaneously across vast zones. We can now move on to examine the changes these movements cause on the surface and in the internal structure of the earth's crust.

452 Deficiency of ancient accounts.—It is only within the last century and a half, since Hooke first promulgated, in 1688, his views respecting the connection between geological phenomena and earthquakes, that the permanent changes affected by these convulsions have excited attention. Before that time, the narrative of the historian was almost exclusively confined to the number of human beings who perished, the number of cities laid in ruins, the value of property destroyed, or certain atmospheric appearances which dazzled or terrified the observers. The creation of a new lake, the engulfing of a new city, or the raising of a new island, are sometimes, it is true, adverted to, as being too obvious, or of too much geographical or political interest to be passed over in silence. But no researches were made expressly with a view of ascertaining the amount of depression or elevation of the ground, or any particular alterations in the relative position of sea and land; and very little distinction was made between the raising of soil by volcanic ejections, and the upheaving of it by forces acting from below. The same remark applies to a very large proportion of modern accounts: and how much reason we have to regret this deficiency of information appears from this, that in every instance where a spirit of scientific inquiry has animated the eyewitnesses of these events, facts calculated to throw light on former modifications of the earth's structure are recorded.

452 Lack of ancient records.—It’s only been in the last century and a half, since Hooke first shared his ideas in 1688 about the link between geological events and earthquakes, that people have really started paying attention to the lasting changes caused by these tremors. Before that, historians mainly focused on how many people died, how many cities were destroyed, the value of lost property, or certain weather phenomena that amazed or scared witnesses. Occasionally, things like the formation of a new lake, the sinking of a city, or the emergence of a new island were noted because they were too significant or interesting geographically or politically to ignore. However, no serious studies were conducted to determine how much land had risen or fallen or to look into specific changes in the relationship between land and sea; little attention was paid to whether land was raised by volcanic activity or by forces working from beneath. The same can be said for a significant number of modern accounts; and we have plenty of reason to miss this lack of information, as every time a scientific curiosity drives eyewitnesses to record events, facts that could clarify past changes in the Earth's structure come to light.

Phenomena attending earthquakes.—As I shall confine myself almost entirely, in the following notice of earthquakes, to the changes brought about by them in the configuration of the earth's crust, I may mention, generally, some accompaniments of these terrible events which are almost uniformly commemorated in history, that it may be unnecessary to advert to them again. Irregularities in the seasons preceding or following the shocks; sudden gusts of wind, interrupted by dead calms; violent rains at unusual seasons, or in countries where such phenomena are almost unknown; a reddening of the sun's disk, and a haziness in the air, often continued for months; an evolution of electric matter, or of inflammable gas from the soil, with sulphurous and mephitic vapors; noises underground, like the running of carriages, or the discharge of artillery, or distant thunder; animals uttering cries of distress, and evincing extraordinary alarm, being more sensitive than men of the slightest movement; a sensation like sea-sickness, and a dizziness in the head, experienced by men:—these, and other phenomena, less connected with our present subject as geologists, have recurred again and again at distant ages, and in all parts of the globe.

Phenomena related to earthquakes.—As I will focus almost entirely in the following discussion of earthquakes on the changes they cause in the earth's crust, I should mention some common occurrences associated with these devastating events that are almost always noted in history, so it may be unnecessary to mention them again. Irregular weather patterns before or after the shocks; sudden gusts of wind followed by stillness; heavy rains at unusual times, or in places where such events are almost unheard of; a reddening of the sun, along with hazy air that can last for months; the release of electric energy or flammable gas from the ground, accompanied by sulfurous and toxic fumes; sounds underground, resembling the rumble of carriages, the firing of cannons, or distant thunder; animals making distress calls and showing unusual fear, being more sensitive to even slight movements than humans; a sensation similar to seasickness, and dizziness experienced by people:—these and other phenomena, somewhat less relevant to our current focus as geologists, have occurred repeatedly throughout history and in all regions of the world.

I shall now begin the enumeration of earthquakes with the latest authentic narratives, and so carry back the survey retrospectively, that I may bring before the reader, in the first place, the minute and circumstantial details of modern times, and thus enable him, by observing the extraordinary amount of change within the last 150 years, to perceive how great must be the deficiency in the meager annals of earlier eras.

I will now start listing earthquakes using the most recent verified accounts, while also looking back to provide a comprehensive overview. This way, I can present the detailed and specific information from modern times, allowing the reader to see the significant changes that have occurred over the last 150 years and understand how lacking the records from earlier periods are.

EARTHQUAKES OF THE NINETEENTH CENTURY.622

Syria, January, 1837.—It has been remarked that earthquakes affect elongated areas. The violent shock which devastated Syria in 1837 was felt on a line 500 miles in length by 90 in breadth:623 more than 6000 persons perished; deep rents were caused in solid rocks, and new hot springs burst out at Tabereah.

Syria, January, 1837.—It has been noted that earthquakes impact long, narrow regions. The intense quake that hit Syria in 1837 was registered over an area 500 miles long and 90 miles wide:623 more than 6000 people lost their lives; deep cracks appeared in solid rocks, and new hot springs emerged at Tabereah.

Chili—Valdivia, 1837.—One of the latest earthquakes by which the position of solid land is known to have been permanently altered is that which occurred in Chili, on November 7th, 1837. On that day Valdivia was destroyed by an earthquake, and a whaler, commanded by Captain Coste, was violently shaken at sea, and lost her masts, in lat. 43° 38' S. in sight of the land. The captain went on the 11th of December following to a spot near the island of Lemus, one of the Chonos archipelago, where he had anchored two years before, and found that the bottom of the sea had been raised more than eight feet. Some rocks formerly covered at all times by the sea were now constantly exposed, and an enormous quantity of shells and fish in a decaying state, which had been thrown there by the waves, or suddenly laid dry during the earthquake, attested the recent date of the occurrence. The whole coast was strewed with uprooted trees.624

Chili—Valdivia, 1837.—One of the most recent earthquakes that is known to have permanently changed the position of solid land happened in Chili on November 7th, 1837. On that day, Valdivia was destroyed by an earthquake, and a whaler, led by Captain Coste, was violently shaken at sea and lost its masts, at latitude 43° 38' S., visible from the land. The captain went on December 11th to a location near the island of Lemus, part of the Chonos archipelago, where he had anchored two years earlier, and discovered that the seabed had risen more than eight feet. Some rocks that were always underwater were now constantly exposed, and a massive amount of shells and decaying fish, which had been tossed there by the waves or suddenly left dry during the earthquake, confirmed that the event was recent. The entire coast was littered with uprooted trees.624

Chili—Conception, 1835.—Fortunately we have a still more detailed account of the geographical changes produced in the same country on the 20th of February, 1835. An earthquake was then felt at all places between Copiapo and Chiloe, from north to south, and from Mendoza to Juan Fernandez, from east to west. "Vessels," says Mr. Caldcleugh, "navigating the Pacific, within 100 miles of the coast, experienced the shock with considerable force."625 Conception, Talcahuano, Chillan, and other towns were thrown down. From the account of Captain Fitz Roy, R. N., who was then employed in surveying the coast, we learn that after the shock the sea retired in the Bay of Conception, and the vessels grounded, even those which had been lying in seven fathoms water: all the shoals were visible, and soon afterwards a wave rushed in and then retreated, and was followed by two other waves. The vertical height of these waves does not appear to have been much greater than from sixteen to twenty feet, although they rose to much greater heights when they broke upon a sloping beach.

Chili—Conception, 1835.—Fortunately, we have an even more detailed account of the geographical changes that occurred in the same area on February 20, 1835. An earthquake was felt everywhere from Copiapo to Chiloe, running north to south, and from Mendoza to Juan Fernandez, east to west. "Vessels," says Mr. Caldcleugh, "navigating the Pacific, within 100 miles of the coast, experienced the shock with considerable force."625 Conception, Talcahuano, Chillan, and other towns were devastated. According to Captain Fitz Roy, R. N., who was surveying the coast at the time, after the shock, the sea receded in the Bay of Conception, and the ships ran aground, even those that had been in seven fathoms of water: all the shoals were visible, and soon after, a wave surged in and then retreated, followed by two more waves. The vertical height of these waves didn’t seem to exceed about sixteen to twenty feet, although they rose much higher when they broke on a sloping beach.

Fig. 69. Map of Chilian Andes.

According to Mr. Caldcleugh and Mr. Darwin, the whole volcanic 454 chain of the Chilian Andes, a range 150 miles in length, was in a state of unusual activity, both during the shocks and for some time preceding and after the convulsion, and lava was seen to flow from the crater of Osorno. (See Map, fig. 69.) The island of Juan Fernandez, distant 365 geographical miles from Chili, was violently shaken at the same time, and devastated by a great wave. A submarine volcano broke out 455 there near Bacalao Head, about a mile from the shore, in sixty-nine fathoms water, and illumined the whole island during the night.626

According to Mr. Caldcleugh and Mr. Darwin, the entire volcanic chain of the Chilean Andes, which stretches 150 miles, was unusually active both during the tremors and for some time before and after the event, with lava observed pouring out of the Osorno crater. (See Map, fig. 69.) The island of Juan Fernandez, located 365 geographical miles from Chile, also experienced severe shaking at the same time and was hit by a massive wave. A submarine volcano erupted near Bacalao Head, about a mile from shore, in sixty-nine fathoms of water, lighting up the entire island throughout the night.626

"At Conception," says Captain Fitz Roy, "the earth opened and closed rapidly in numerous places. The direction of the cracks was not uniform, though generally from southeast to northwest. The earth was not quiet for three days after the great shock, and more than 300 shocks were counted between the 20th February and the 4th of March. The loose earth of the valley of the Biobio was everywhere parted from the solid rocks which bound the plain, there being an opening between them from an inch to a foot in width.

"At Conception," says Captain Fitz Roy, "the ground opened and closed quickly in many places. The direction of the cracks wasn’t the same everywhere, but they mostly ran from southeast to northwest. The ground was restless for three days after the major shock, and over 300 shocks were recorded between February 20th and March 4th. The loose soil in the Biobio Valley was separated from the solid rocks that bordered the plain, with gaps ranging from an inch to a foot wide."

Fig. 70. Santa Maria Island,

"For some days after the 20th of February, the sea at Talcahuano," says Captain Fitz Roy, "did not rise to the usual marks by four or five feet vertically. When walking on the shore, even at high water, beds of dead mussels, numerous chitons, and limpets, and withered seaweed, still adhering, though lifeless, to the rocks on which they had lived, everywhere met the eye." But this difference in the relative level of the land and sea gradually diminished, till in the middle of April the water rose again to within two feet of the former high-water mark. It might be supposed that these changes of level merely indicated a temporary disturbance in the set of the currents or in the height of the tides at Talcahuano; but, on considering what occurred in the neighboring island of Santa Maria, Captain Fitz Roy concluded that the land had 456 been raised four or five feet in February, and that it had returned in April to within two or three feet of its former level.

"For several days after February 20th, the sea at Talcahuano," says Captain Fitz Roy, "didn't rise to the usual levels by four or five feet. When walking along the shore, even at high tide, you could see beds of dead mussels, various chitons, limpets, and dried seaweed, still clinging to the rocks where they once thrived, but now lifeless." However, this difference in the relative levels of land and sea gradually lessened, until mid-April when the water rose again to within two feet of the previous high-water mark. One might think these changes in level were just temporary disturbances in the currents or tides at Talcahuano; but, considering what happened on the nearby island of Santa Maria, Captain Fitz Roy concluded that the land had been raised four or five feet in February and had returned in April to within two or three feet of its original level.

Santa Maria, the island just alluded to, is about seven miles long and two broad, and about twenty-five miles southwest of Conception. (See Map, fig. 70.) The phenomena observed there are most important. "It appeared," says Captain Fitz Roy, who visited Santa Maria twice, the first time at the end of March, and afterwards in the beginning of April, "that the southern extremity of the island had been raised eight feet, the middle nine, and the northern end upwards of ten feet. On steep rocks, where vertical measures could be correctly taken, beds of dead mussels were found ten feet above high-water mark. One foot lower than the highest bed of mussels, a few limpets and chitons were seen adhering to the rock where they had grown. Two feet lower than the same, dead mussels, chitons, and limpets were abundant.

Santa Maria, the island mentioned earlier, is about seven miles long and two miles wide, located around twenty-five miles southwest of Conception. (See Map, fig. 70.) The events observed there are very significant. "It seemed," says Captain Fitz Roy, who visited Santa Maria twice, first at the end of March and then again at the beginning of April, "that the southern end of the island had risen eight feet, the middle nine feet, and the northern end more than ten feet. On steep rocks, where vertical measurements could be accurately taken, beds of dead mussels were found ten feet above the high-water mark. One foot lower than the highest bed of mussels, a few limpets and chitons were spotted clinging to the rock where they had grown. Two feet lower than that, there were plenty of dead mussels, chitons, and limpets."

"An extensive rocky flat lies around the northern parts of Santa Maria. Before the earthquake this flat was covered by the sea, some projecting rocks only showing themselves. Now, the whole flat is exposed, and square acres of it are covered with dead shell-fish, the stench arising from which is abominable. By this elevation of the land the southern port of Santa Maria has been almost destroyed; little shelter remaining there, and very bad landing." The surrounding sea is also stated to have become shallower in exactly the same proportion as the land had risen; the soundings having diminished a fathom and a half everywhere around the island.

"An extensive rocky flat stretches across the northern parts of Santa Maria. Before the earthquake, this area was submerged under the sea, with only a few rocks peeking out. Now, the entire flat is exposed, and large sections of it are covered with dead shellfish, creating an awful smell. This rise in land has nearly destroyed the southern port of Santa Maria; there's little shelter left, and the landing conditions are very poor. Additionally, the surrounding sea is reported to have become shallower by the same amount that the land has risen, with the depths decreasing by a fathom and a half all around the island."

At Tubal, also, to the southeast of Santa Maria, the land was raised six feet, at Mocha two feet, but no elevation could be ascertained at Valdivia.

At Tubal, also to the southeast of Santa Maria, the land was elevated by six feet, at Mocha by two feet, but no height could be determined at Valdivia.

Among other effects of the catastrophe, it is stated that cattle standing on a steep slope, near the shore, were rolled down into the sea, and many others were washed off by the great wave from low land and drowned.627

Among other effects of the disaster, it is reported that cattle standing on a steep slope near the shore were swept down into the sea, and many others were taken away by the massive wave from low land and drowned.627

In November of the same year (1835), Conception was shaken by a severe earthquake, and on the same day Osorno, at the distance of 400 miles, renewed its activity. These facts prove not only the connection of earthquakes with volcanic eruptions in this region, but also the vast extent of the subterranean areas over which the disturbing cause acts simultaneously.

In November of the same year (1835), Conception was hit by a strong earthquake, and on that same day, Osorno, located 400 miles away, became active again. These events demonstrate not just the link between earthquakes and volcanic eruptions in this area, but also the wide range of the underground regions affected by the same disturbances at the same time.

Ischia, 1828.—On the 2d of February the whole island of Ischia was shaken by an earthquake, and in the October following I found all the houses in Casamicciol still without their roofs. On the sides of a ravine between that town and Forio, I saw masses of greenish tuff which had been thrown down. The hot-spring of Rita, which was nearest the centre of the movement, was ascertained by M. Covelli to have increased in temperature, showing, as he observes, that the explosion took place below the reservoirs which heat the thermal waters.628

Ischia, 1828.—On February 2nd, the entire island of Ischia experienced an earthquake, and by the following October, I found all the houses in Casamicciola still without their roofs. Along the sides of a ravine between that town and Forio, I observed large chunks of greenish tuff that had fallen. M. Covelli confirmed that the hot spring of Rita, which was closest to the epicenter of the quake, had increased in temperature, indicating, as he noted, that the explosion occurred beneath the reservoirs heating the thermal waters.628

457 Bogota, 1827.—On the 16th of November, 1827, the plain of Bogota, in New Granada, or Colombia, was convulsed by an earthquake, and a great number of towns were thrown down. Torrents of rain swelled the Magdalena, sweeping along vast quantities of mud and other substances, which emitted a sulphurous vapor and destroyed the fish. Popayan, which is distant 200 geographical miles S. S. W. of Bogota, suffered greatly. Wide crevices appeared in the road of Guanacas, leaving no doubt that the whole of the Cordilleras sustained a powerful shock. Other fissures opened near Costa, in the plains of Bogota, into which the river Tunza immediately began to flow.629 It is worthy of remark, that in all such cases the ancient gravel bed of a river is deserted and a new one formed at a lower level; so that a want of relation in the position of alluvial beds of the existing water-courses may be no test of the high antiquity of such deposits, at least in countries habitually convulsed by earthquakes. Extraordinary rains accompanied the shocks before mentioned; and two volcanoes are said to have been in eruption in the mountain-chain nearest to Bogota.

457 Bogota, 1827.—On November 16, 1827, the plain of Bogota, in New Granada, or Colombia, was struck by an earthquake, causing the collapse of many towns. Heavy rain flooded the Magdalena, carrying away large amounts of mud and other materials that released a sulfurous odor and killed the fish. Popayan, located 200 geographical miles S.S.W. of Bogota, experienced significant damage. Wide cracks appeared on the Guanacas road, indicating that the entire Cordilleras endured a strong shock. Other fissures opened near Costa, in the plains of Bogota, into which the Tunza river quickly began to flow.629 It's noteworthy that in all such instances, the ancient gravel bed of a river is abandoned and a new one is formed at a lower elevation; thus, a lack of correlation in the placement of alluvial beds of current watercourses may not indicate the great age of these deposits, at least in regions frequently shaken by earthquakes. Unusual rainfall accompanied the aforementioned shocks, and two volcanoes are reported to have erupted in the mountain range closest to Bogota.

Chili, 1822.—On the 19th of November, 1822, the coast of Chili was visited by a most destructive earthquake. The shock was felt simultaneously throughout a space of 1200 miles from north to south. St. Jago, Valparaiso, and some other places, were greatly injured. When the district round Valparaiso was examined on the morning after the shock, it was found that the coast for a considerable distance was raised above its former level.630 At Valparaiso the elevation was three feet, and at Quintero about four feet. Part of the bed of the sea, says Mrs. Graham, remained bare and dry at high water, "with beds of oysters, mussels, and other shells adhering to the rocks on which they grew, the fish being all dead, and exhaling most offensive effluvia.631

Chile, 1822.—On November 19, 1822, the coast of Chile was struck by a devastating earthquake. The tremor was felt across an area of 1,200 miles from north to south. St. Jago, Valparaiso, and several other locations suffered significant damage. When the area around Valparaiso was inspected the morning after the quake, it was discovered that the coastline had been raised for a considerable distance. At Valparaiso, the elevation was three feet, and at Quintero, about four feet. Part of the sea floor, according to Mrs. Graham, was left exposed and dry even at high tide, "with beds of oysters, mussels, and other shells clinging to the rocks on which they had grown, the fish all dead, and giving off a very unpleasant smell."

An old wreck of a ship, which before could not be approached, became accessible from the land, although its distance from the original sea-shore had not altered. It was observed that the water-course of a mill, at the distance of about a mile from the sea, gained a fall of fourteen inches, in little more than one hundred yards; and from this fact it is inferred that the rise in some parts of the inland country was far more considerable than on the borders of the ocean.632 Part of the coast thus elevated consisted of granite, in which parallel fissures were caused, some of which were traced for a mile and a half inland. Cones of earth about four feet high were thrown up in several districts, by the forcing up of water mixed with sand through funnel-shaped hollows,—a phenomenon very common in Calabria, and the explanation of which will hereafter be considered. Those houses in Chili of which the foundations were on rock were less damaged than such as were built on alluvial soil.

An old wrecked ship, which was previously unreachable, became accessible from the shore, even though its distance from the original coastline hadn’t changed. It was noted that the water flow of a mill, about a mile from the sea, gained a drop of fourteen inches over just a little more than one hundred yards; from this, it’s inferred that the rise in certain parts of the inland area was much greater than along the ocean's edge.632 Part of the elevated coastline was made up of granite, where parallel cracks formed, some of which extended a mile and a half inland. Cones of earth about four feet high were pushed up in several areas by water mixed with sand forcing its way through funnel-shaped holes—a phenomenon commonly seen in Calabria, the explanation of which will be discussed later. Houses in Chile with rock foundations suffered less damage than those built on alluvial soil.

Mr. Cruickshanks, an English botanist, who resided in the country 458 during the earthquake, has informed me that some rocks of greenstone at Quintero, a few hundred yards from the beach, which had always been under water till the shock of 1822, have since been uncovered when the tide is at half-ebb: and he states that, after the earthquake, it was the general belief of the fishermen and inhabitants of the Chilian coast, not that the land had risen, but that the ocean had permanently retreated.

Mr. Cruickshanks, an English botanist who lived in the countryside 458 during the earthquake, has told me that some greenstone rocks at Quintero, a few hundred yards from the beach, which had always been underwater until the shock of 1822, have now been exposed when the tide is at half-ebb. He mentions that, after the earthquake, the general belief among the fishermen and residents of the Chilean coast was not that the land had risen, but that the ocean had permanently retreated.

Dr. Meyen, a Prussian traveller, who visited Valparaiso in 1831, says that on examining the rocks both north and south of the town, nine years after the event, he found, in corroboration of Mrs. Graham's account, that remains of animals and sea-weed, the Lessonia of Bory de St. Vincent, which has a firm ligneous stem, still adhered to those rocks which in 1822 had been elevated above high-water mark.633 According to the same author, the whole coast of Central Chili was raised about four feet, and banks of marine shells were laid dry on many parts of the coast. He observed similar banks, elevated at unknown periods, in several places, especially at Copiapo, where the species all agree with those now living in the ocean. Mr. Freyer also, who resided some years in South America, has confirmed these statements;634 and Mr. Darwin obtained evidence that the remains of an ancient wall, formerly washed by the sea, and now 11½ feet above high-water mark, acquired several feet of this additional elevation during the earthquake of 1822.635

Dr. Meyen, a Prussian traveler, who visited Valparaiso in 1831, states that after looking at the rocks both north and south of the town, nine years later, he found, supporting Mrs. Graham's account, that remains of animals and seaweed, the Lessonia of Bory de St. Vincent, which has a sturdy woody stem, still stuck to those rocks which had been raised above high-water mark in 1822.633 According to the same author, the entire coast of Central Chile was lifted about four feet, and banks of marine shells were left dry in many coastal areas. He noted similar elevated banks at various places, especially at Copiapo, where the species were consistent with those currently found in the ocean. Mr. Freyer, who lived in South America for several years, also confirmed these claims;634 and Mr. Darwin provided evidence that the remains of an ancient wall, which was previously washed by the sea and is now 11½ feet above high-water mark, gained several feet of this extra height during the earthquake of 1822.635

The shocks continued up to the end of September, 1823; even then, forty-eight hours seldom passed without one, and sometimes two or three were felt during twenty-four hours. Mrs. Graham observed, after the earthquake of 1822, that besides a beach newly raised above highwater mark, there were several older elevated lines of beach, one above the other, consisting of shingle mixed with shells extending in a parallel direction to the shore, to the height of fifty feet above the sea.636

The shocks continued until the end of September 1823; even then, hardly a day went by without one, and sometimes two or three could be felt within twenty-four hours. Mrs. Graham noted, after the earthquake of 1822, that besides a beach that had recently been raised above high water mark, there were several older elevated lines of beach, stacked on top of each other, made up of shingle mixed with shells and extending parallel to the shore, up to fifty feet above the sea.636

Extent of country elevated.—By some observers it has been supposed that the whole country from the foot of the Andes to a great distance under the sea was upraised in 1822, the greatest rise being at the distance of about two miles from the shore. "The rise upon the coast was from two to four feet:—at the distance of a mile inland it must have been from five to six or seven feet."637 It has also been conjectured by the same eye-witnesses to the convulsion, that the area over which this permanent alteration of level extended may have been equal to 100,000 square miles. Although the increased fall of certain water-courses may have afforded some ground for this conjecture, it must be considered as very hypothetical, and the estimate may have exceeded or greatly fallen short of the truth. It may nevertheless be useful to reflect on the enormous amount of change which this single convulsion occasioned, if the 459 extent of country moved upward really amounted to 100,000 square miles,—an extent just equal to half the area of France, or about five-sixths of the area of Great Britain and Ireland. If we suppose the elevation to have been only three feet on an average, it will be seen that the mass of rock added to the continent of America by the movement, or, in other words, the mass previously below the level of the sea, and after the shocks permanently above it, must have contained fifty-seven cubic miles in bulk; which would be sufficient to form a conical mountain two miles high (or about as high as Etna), with a circumference at the base of nearly thirty-three miles. We may take the mean specific gravity of the rock at 2·655,—a fair average, and a convenient one in such computations, because at such a rate a cubic yard weighs two tons. Then, assuming the great pyramid of Egypt, if solid, to weigh, in accordance with an estimate before given, six million tons, we may state the rock added to the continent by the Chilian earthquake to have more than equalled 100,000 pyramids.

Extent of country elevated.—Some observers believe that the entire area from the base of the Andes to a significant distance under the ocean was lifted in 1822, with the most notable rise occurring about two miles from the shore. "The rise along the coast was between two and four feet;—a mile inland, it must have been between five and six or seven feet." 637 Eyewitnesses of the event also speculated that the region affected by this lasting change in elevation might have totaled around 100,000 square miles. While the increased flow of certain rivers might support this idea, it should be considered very speculative, and the actual area could be either overestimated or underestimated. Nonetheless, it’s worth considering the immense change caused by this single event, assuming the area that was raised truly covered 100,000 square miles—an area roughly equal to half of France or about five-sixths of Great Britain and Ireland. If we assume the average elevation was only three feet, it becomes clear that the volume of rock added to the continent of America by this movement—meaning the mass that was previously underwater and is now permanently above it—must have amounted to fifty-seven cubic miles. This mass would be enough to create a conical mountain two miles high (about the height of Mount Etna) with a base circumference of nearly thirty-three miles. We can consider the average specific gravity of the rock to be 2.655—a reasonable average and convenient for such calculations, since at this density, a cubic yard weighs two tons. Assuming the Great Pyramid of Egypt, if solid, weighs around six million tons, we could say that the rock added to the continent due to the Chilean earthquake equaled more than 100,000 pyramids.

But it must always be borne in mind that the weight of rock here alluded to constituted but an insignificant part of the whole amount which the volcanic forces had to overcome. The whole thickness of rock between the surface of Chili and the subterranean foci of volcanic action may be many miles or leagues deep. Say that the thickness was only two miles, even then the mass which changed place and rose three feet being 200,000 cubic miles in volume, must have exceeded in weight 363 million pyramids.

But it’s important to remember that the amount of rock mentioned here was just a tiny fraction of the total that the volcanic forces had to deal with. The entire thickness of rock between the surface of Chile and the underground sources of volcanic activity could be many miles deep. Even if we say that the thickness was only two miles, the volume of the mass that moved and rose three feet, which is 200,000 cubic miles, would weigh more than 363 million pyramids.

It may be instructing to consider these results in connection with others already obtained from a different source, and to compare the working of two antagonistic forces—the levelling power of running water, and the expansive energy of subterranean heat. How long, it may be asked, would the Ganges require, according to data before explained (p. 283), to transport to the sea a quantity of solid matter equal to that which may have been added to the land by the Chilian earthquake? The discharge of mud in one year by the Ganges was estimated at 20,000 million cubic feet. According to that estimate it would require about four centuries (or 418 years) before the river could bear down from the continent into the sea a mass equal to that gained by the Chilian earthquake. In about half that time, perhaps, the united waters of the Ganges and Burrampooter might accomplish the operation.

It might be helpful to look at these results alongside others we've gathered from different sources and to compare the effects of two opposing forces—the eroding power of flowing water and the expanding force of underground heat. How long, one might wonder, would it take the Ganges to carry to the sea a volume of solid matter equal to what was added to the land by the Chilean earthquake, based on the data previously discussed (p. 283)? The estimated mud discharge by the Ganges in one year is about 20 billion cubic feet. Based on that estimate, it would take roughly four centuries (or 418 years) for the river to transport a mass equal to what was contributed by the Chilean earthquake. However, perhaps in about half that time, the combined waters of the Ganges and Brahmaputra could achieve that task.

Cutch, 1819.—A violent earthquake occurred at Cutch, in the delta of the Indus, on the 16th of June, 1819. (See Map, fig. 71.) The principal town, Bhooj, was converted into a heap of ruins, and its stone buildings were thrown down. The movement was felt over an area having a radius of 1000 miles from Bhooj, and extending to Kbatmandoo, Calcutta, and Pondicherry.638 The vibrations were felt in Northwest India, at a distance of 800 miles, after an interval of about fifteen minutes after the earthquake at Bhooj. At Ahmedabad the great 460 mosque, erected by Sultan Ahmed nearly 450 years before, fell to the ground, attesting how long a period had elapsed since a shock of similar violence had visited that point. At Anjar, the fort, with its tower and guns, was hurled to the ground in one common mass of ruin. The shocks continued until the 20th; when, thirty miles northwest from Bhooj, the volcano called Denodur is said by some to have sent forth flames, but Capt. Grant was unable to authenticate this statement.

Cutch, 1819.—A powerful earthquake struck Cutch, in the delta of the Indus, on June 16, 1819. (See Map, fig. 71.) The main town, Bhooj, was turned into rubble, and its stone buildings collapsed. The quake was felt over a 1000-mile radius from Bhooj, reaching Kbatmandoo, Calcutta, and Pondicherry.638 The vibrations were detected in Northwest India, 800 miles away, about fifteen minutes after the earthquake hit Bhooj. In Ahmedabad, the great mosque built by Sultan Ahmed nearly 450 years earlier fell to the ground, showing how long it had been since a quake of similar intensity had occurred there. At Anjar, the fort, along with its tower and cannons, was reduced to a massive ruin. The tremors continued until the 20th; on that day, thirty miles northwest of Bhooj, some claimed that the volcano called Denodur erupted with flames, but Capt. Grant could not confirm this report.

Fig. 71.Map of the delta of the Indus,.

Subsidence in the delta of the Indus.—Although the ruin of towns was great, the face of nature in the inland country, says Captain Macmurdo, was not visibly altered. In the hills some large masses only of rock and soil were detached from the precipices; but the eastern and almost deserted channel of the Indus, which bounds the province of Cutch, was greatly changed. This estuary, or inlet of the sea, was, before the earthquake, fordable at Luckput, being only about a foot deep when the tide was at ebb, and at flood-tide never more than six feet; but it was deepened at the fort of Luckput, after the shock, to more than eighteen feet at low water.639 On sounding other parts of the channel, it was found, that where previously the depth of the water at flood never exceeded one or two feet, it had become from four to ten feet deep. By these and other remarkable changes of level, a part of the inland navigation of that country, which had been closed for centuries, became again practicable.

Subsidence in the delta of the Indus.—Even though many towns were destroyed, Captain Macmurdo notes that the landscape in the inland areas didn’t change much. In the hills, only some large chunks of rock and soil broke off from the cliffs; however, the eastern and nearly deserted channel of the Indus, which borders the province of Cutch, underwent significant changes. This estuary or inlet of the sea was passable at Luckput before the earthquake, being about a foot deep at low tide and never more than six feet at high tide; but after the quake, it was deepened at the fort of Luckput to more than eighteen feet at low water.639 When measuring other parts of the channel, it was discovered that areas which previously had a flood depth of one or two feet were now between four and ten feet deep. Due to these and other significant changes in water levels, parts of the inland waterways that had been closed off for centuries became usable again.

Fig. 72.Fort of Sindree, on the eastern branch of the Indus.

Fort of Sindree, on the eastern branch of the Indus, before it was submerged by the earthquake of 1819, from a sketch of Capt. Grindlay, made in 1808.

Fort of Sindree, on the eastern branch of the Indus, before it was underwater due to the earthquake of 1819, from a drawing by Capt. Grindlay, done in 1808.

Fort and village submerged.640—The fort and village of Sindree, on the eastern arm of the Indus, above Luckput, are stated by the same writer to have been overflowed; and, after the shock, the tops of the houses and wall were alone to be seen above the water, for the houses, although submerged, were not cast down. Had they been situated, therefore, in the interior, where so many forts were levelled to the ground, their site would, perhaps, have been regarded as having remained comparatively unmoved. Hence we may suspect that great permanent upheavings and depressions of soil may be the result of earthquakes, without the inhabitants being in the least degree conscious of any change of level.

Fort and village submerged.640—According to the same author, the fort and village of Sindree, located on the eastern arm of the Indus River, above Luckput, were flooded. After the shock, only the tops of the houses and walls were visible above the water, as the houses, though submerged, were not destroyed. If they had been situated inland, where many forts were completely flattened, their location might have been seen as less affected. Therefore, we can suspect that significant and permanent shifts in the ground can result from earthquakes, even if the residents are completely unaware of any change in elevation.

A more recent survey of Cutch, by Sir A. Burnes, who was not in communication with Capt. Macmurdo, confirms the facts above enumerated, and adds many important details.641 That officer examined the delta of the Indus in 1826 and 1828, and from his account it appears that, when Sindree subsided in June, 1819, the sea flowed in by the eastern mouth of the Indus, and in a few hours converted a tract of land, 2000 square miles in area, into an inland sea, or lagoon. Neither the rush of the sea into this new depression, nor the movement of the earthquake, threw down entirely the small fort of Sindree, one of the four towers, the northwestern, still continuing to stand; and, the day after the earthquake, the inhabitants who had ascended to the top of this tower, saved themselves in boats.642

A more recent survey of Cutch by Sir A. Burnes, who did not communicate with Capt. Macmurdo, confirms the facts mentioned above and adds many important details.641 That officer examined the delta of the Indus in 1826 and 1828, and from his account, it appears that when Sindree collapsed in June 1819, the sea rushed in through the eastern mouth of the Indus and within a few hours turned a land area of 2000 square miles into an inland sea or lagoon. Neither the onrush of the sea into this new depression nor the earthquake completely destroyed the small fort of Sindree, one of the four towers, with the northwestern tower still standing; and the day after the earthquake, the residents who had climbed to the top of this tower saved themselves using boats.642

462 Elevation of the Ullah Bund.—Immediately after the shock, the inhabitants of Sindree saw, at the distance of five miles and a half from their village, a long elevated mound, where previously there had been a low and perfectly level plain. (See Map, fig. 71.) To this uplifted tract they gave the name of "Ullah Bund," or the "Mound of God," to distinguish it from several artificial dams previously thrown across the eastern arm of the Indus.

462 Elevation of the Ullah Bund.—Right after the shock, the people of Sindree noticed, about five and a half miles away from their village, a long raised mound where there used to be a flat and even plain. (See Map, fig. 71.) They named this raised land "Ullah Bund," meaning "Mound of God," to set it apart from several artificial barriers that had already been built across the eastern arm of the Indus.

Extent of country raised.—It has been ascertained that this new-raised country is upwards of fifty miles in length from east to west, running parallel to that line of subsidence before mentioned, which caused the grounds around Sindree to be flooded. The range of this elevation extends from Puchum Island towards Gharee; its breadth from north to south is conjectured to be in some parts sixteen miles, and its greatest ascertained height above the original level of the delta is ten feet,—an elevation which appears to the eye to be very uniform throughout.

Extent of country raised.—It has been confirmed that this newly raised land stretches over fifty miles in length from east to west, running parallel to the subsidence line previously mentioned, which caused the areas around Sindree to flood. This uplifted region extends from Puchum Island towards Gharee; its width from north to south is estimated to be about sixteen miles in some areas, and its highest verified point above the original delta level is ten feet—an elevation that looks quite uniform overall.

For several years after the convulsion of 1819, the course of the Indus was very unsettled, and at length, in 1826, the river threw a vast body of water into its eastern arm, that called the Phurraun, above Sindree; and forcing its way in a more direct course to the sea, burst through all the artificial dams which had been thrown across its channel, and at length cut right through the "Ullah Bund," whereby a natural section was obtained. In the perpendicular cliffs thus laid open Sir A. Burnes found that the upraised lands consisted of clay filled with shells. The new channel of the river where it intersected the "bund" was eighteen feet deep, and forty yards in width; but in 1828 the channel was still farther enlarged. The Indus, when it first opened this new passage, threw such a body of water into the new mere, or salt lagoon, of Sindree, that it became fresh for many months; but it had recovered its saltness in 1828, when the supply of river-water was less copious, and finally it became more salt than the sea, in consequence, as the natives suggested to Sir A. Burnes, of the saline particles with which the "Runn of Cutch" is impregnated.

For several years after the upheaval of 1819, the Indus River was very unpredictable. Finally, in 1826, the river diverted a large amount of water into its eastern branch, known as the Phurraun, above Sindree. It forced its way toward the sea, breaking through all the man-made barriers that had been built across its path, ultimately cutting through the "Ullah Bund," creating a natural passage. In the steep cliffs that were exposed, Sir A. Burnes discovered that the raised land was made of clay filled with shells. The new river channel where it intersected the "bund" was eighteen feet deep and forty yards wide; however, by 1828, the channel had expanded even more. When the Indus first opened this new route, it sent such a massive flow of water into the new lake, or salt lagoon, of Sindree that it remained fresh for many months. But by 1828, as the river water became less abundant, it returned to its salty state. Eventually, it became saltier than the sea, likely due to the saline particles found in the "Runn of Cutch," as the locals pointed out to Sir A. Burnes.

In 1828 Sir A. Burnes went in a boat to the ruins of Sindree, where a single remaining tower was seen in the midst of a wide expanse of sea. The tops of the ruined walls still rose two or three feet above the level of the water; and standing on one of these, he could behold nothing in the horizon but water, except in one direction, where a blue streak of land to the north indicated the Ullah Bund. This scene presents to the imagination a lively picture of the revolutions now in progress on the earth—a waste of waters where a few years before all was land, and the only land visible consisting of ground uplifted by a recent earthquake.

In 1828, Sir A. Burnes took a boat to the ruins of Sindree, where he found a lone tower standing in a wide stretch of sea. The tops of the crumbling walls rose two or three feet above the water level; and while standing on one of these, he could see nothing on the horizon but water, except in one direction, where a blue line of land to the north marked the Ullah Bund. This scene paints a vivid picture of the changes happening on the earth—an expanse of water where just a few years earlier there was land, and the only visible land was ground pushed up by a recent earthquake.

Ten years after the visit of Sir A. Burnes above alluded to, my friend, Captain Grant, F. G. S., of the Bombay Engineers, had the kindness to send at my request a native surveyor to make a plan of Sindree and Ullah Bund, in March, 1838. From his description it appears that, at 463 that season, the driest of the whole year, he found the channel traversing the Bund to be 100 yards wide, without water, and incrusted with salt. He was told that it has now only four or five feet of water in it after rains. The sides or banks were nearly perpendicular, and nine feet in height. The lagoon has diminished both in area and depth, and part near the fort was dry land. The annexed drawing, made by Captain Grant from the surveyor's plan, shows the appearance of the fort in the midst of the lake, as seen in 1838 from the west, or from the same point as that from which Captain Grindlay's sketch (see fig. 72) was taken in 1808, before the earthquake.

Ten years after the visit of Sir A. Burnes mentioned earlier, my friend, Captain Grant, F. G. S., from the Bombay Engineers, kindly sent a local surveyor at my request to create a map of Sindree and Ullah Bund in March 1838. According to his description, during that season, the driest of the year, he found the channel crossing the Bund to be 100 yards wide, devoid of water, and covered in salt. He reported that it now only has four or five feet of water in it after the rains. The banks were almost vertical and about nine feet high. The lagoon has shrunk in both size and depth, with parts near the fort now dry land. The drawing attached, created by Captain Grant from the surveyor's plan, depicts the appearance of the fort in the middle of the lake, as seen in 1838 from the west, which is the same viewpoint from where Captain Grindlay's sketch (see fig. 72) was made in 1808, before the earthquake.

Fig. 73.View of the Fort of Sindree.

View of the Fort of Sindree, from the west, in March, 1838.

View of the Fort of Sindree, from the west, in March, 1838.

The Runn of Cutch is a flat region of a very peculiar character, and no less than 7000 square miles in area: a greater superficial extent than Yorkshire, or about one-fourth the area of Ireland. It is not a desert of moving sand, nor a marsh, but evidently the dried-up bed of an inland sea, which for a great part of every year has a hard and dry bottom uncovered by weeds or grass, and only supporting here and there a few tamarisks. But during the monsoons, when the sea runs high, the salt-water driven up from the Gulf of Cutch and the creeks at Luckput overflows a large part of the Runn, especially after rains, when the soaked ground permits the sea-water to spread rapidly. The Runn is also liable to be overflowed occasionally in some parts by river-water: and it is remarkable that the only portion which was ever highly cultivated (that anciently called Sayra) is now permanently submerged. The surface of the Runn is sometimes incrusted with salt about an inch in depth, in consequence of the evaporation of the sea-water. Islands rise up in some parts of the waste, and the boundary lands form bays and promontories. The natives have various traditions respecting the former separation of Cutch and Sinde by a bay of the sea, and the drying up of the district called the Runn. But these tales, besides the usual uncertainty of oral tradition, are farther obscured by mythological fictions. The conversion of the Runn into land is chiefly ascribed to the miraculous powers of a Hindoo saint, by name Damorath (or Dhoorunnath), who had previously done penance for twelve years on the summit of Denodur hill. Captain Grant infers, on various grounds, that this saint flourished about the eleventh 464 or twelfth century of our era. In proof of the drying up of the Runn, some towns far inland are still pointed out as having once been ancient ports. It has, moreover, been always said that ships were wrecked and engulphed by the great catastrophe; and in the jets of black muddy water thrown out of fissures in that region, in 1819, there were cast up numerous pieces of wrought-iron and ship nails.643 Cones of sand six or eight feet in height were at the same time thrown up on these lands.644

The Runn of Cutch is a flat area with a unique character, covering about 7000 square miles—larger than Yorkshire and roughly one-fourth the size of Ireland. It's not a desert of shifting sands or a marsh; rather, it appears to be the dried-up bed of an inland sea, which for much of the year has a hard, dry surface with no weeds or grass, only occasionally supporting a few tamarisks. However, during the monsoons, when the sea rises, saltwater from the Gulf of Cutch and the creeks at Luckput floods a large part of the Runn, especially after rainfall, when the saturated ground allows the seawater to spread quickly. In some areas, the Runn can also be occasionally flooded by river water. It’s noteworthy that the only region that was ever highly cultivated (historically known as Sayra) is now permanently underwater. The surface of the Runn sometimes has a crust of salt about an inch thick, due to the evaporation of seawater. Islands emerge in certain parts of the wasteland, and the bordering lands create bays and promontories. Local legends tell of a time when Cutch and Sinde were separated by a bay, and how the Runn dried up. However, these stories, like most oral traditions, are often uncertain and complicated by mythical elements. The transformation of the Runn into land is mostly attributed to the miraculous abilities of a Hindu saint named Damorath (or Dhoorunnath), who spent twelve years in penance on Denodur hill. Captain Grant suggests that this saint lived around the eleventh or twelfth century. To support the idea that the Runn has dried up, some towns further inland are still recognized as having once been ancient ports. Additionally, it has always been claimed that ships were wrecked and swallowed up during a great disaster; and in the jets of black muddy water that emerged from cracks in that area in 1819, many pieces of wrought-iron and ship nails were discovered.643 Sand cones six or eight feet tall were also formed on this land at that time.644

We must not conclude without alluding to a moral phenomenon connected with this tremendous catastrophe, which we regard as highly deserving the attention of geologists. It is stated by Sir A. Burnes, that "these wonderful events passed unheeded by the inhabitants of Cutch;" for the region convulsed, though once fertile, had for a long period been reduced to sterility by want of irrigation, so that the natives were indifferent as to its fate. Now it is to this profound apathy which all but highly civilized nations feel, in regard to physical events not having an immediate influence on their worldly fortunes, that we must ascribe the extraordinary dearth of historical information concerning changes of the earth's surface, which modern observations show to be by no means of rare occurrence in the ordinary course of nature.

We can’t wrap things up without mentioning a moral issue related to this massive disaster, which we think deserves serious attention from geologists. Sir A. Burnes notes that "these incredible events went unnoticed by the people of Cutch;" because the area was once fertile but had been dry and lifeless for a long time due to a lack of irrigation, making the locals indifferent to its fate. This deep indifference, which most less-developed nations exhibit towards physical events that don’t directly impact their lives, explains the remarkable lack of historical records regarding changes in the earth's surface—changes that modern observations show are actually quite common in the natural world.

Since the above account was written, a description has been published of more recent geographical changes in the district of Cutch, near the mouth of the Koree, or eastern branch of the Indus, which happened in June, 1845. A large area seems to have subsided, and the Sindree lake had become a salt marsh.645

Since the account above was written, a description has been released about more recent geographical changes in the Cutch district, near the mouth of the Koree, or the eastern branch of the Indus, which occurred in June 1845. A large area appears to have sunk, and the Sindree lake has turned into a salt marsh.645

Island of Sumbawa, 1815.—In April, 1815, one of the most frightful eruptions recorded in history occurred in the province of Tomboro, in the island of Sumbawa (see Map, fig. 39, p. 351), about 200 miles from the eastern extremity of Java. In April of the year preceding the volcano had been observed in a state of considerable activity, ashes having fallen upon the decks of vessels which sailed past the coast.646 The eruption of 1815 began on the 5th of April, but was most violent on the 11th and 12th, and did not entirely cease till July. The sound of the explosions was heard in Sumatra, at the distance of 970 geographical miles in a direct line; and at Ternate, in an opposite direction, at the distance of 720 miles. Out of a population of 12,000, in the province of Tomboro, only twenty-six individuals survived. Violent whirlwinds carried up men, horses, cattle, and whatever else came within their influence into the air; tore up the largest trees by the roots, and covered the whole sea with floating timber.647 Great tracts of land were covered by lava, several streams of which, issuing from the crater of the Tomboro mountain, reached the sea: So heavy was the fall of ashes, that they broke into the Resident's house at Bima, forty miles east of the volcano, and rendered it as well as many other dwellings in the town uninhabitable. On the side of Java the ashes were carried to the distance of 300 465 miles, and 217 towards Celebes, in sufficient quantity to darken the air. The floating cinders to the westward of Sumatra formed, on the 12th of April, a mass two feet thick, and several miles in extent, through which ships with difficulty forced their way.

Island of Sumbawa, 1815.—In April 1815, one of the most terrifying eruptions in history took place in the province of Tomboro on the island of Sumbawa (see Map, fig. 39, p. 351), around 200 miles from the eastern tip of Java. In April of the previous year, the volcano had shown significant activity, with ashes falling onto the decks of ships passing by the coast.646 The eruption of 1815 started on April 5th, peaked on the 11th and 12th, and didn’t fully stop until July. The sounds of the explosions could be heard in Sumatra, 970 geographical miles away in a straight line, and in Ternate, in the opposite direction, at a distance of 720 miles. Of the 12,000 people in the province of Tomboro, only twenty-six survived. Fierce whirlwinds lifted up men, horses, cattle, and anything else within reach into the air; uprooted the largest trees; and filled the sea with floating debris.647 Large areas of land were blanketed by lava, with several streams flowing from the crater of the Tomboro mountain reaching the sea. The ash fall was so heavy that it broke into the Resident’s house in Bima, forty miles east of the volcano, making it and many other homes in the town uninhabitable. On the Java side, ashes were carried up to 300 miles away, and 217 miles towards Celebes, in enough quantity to darken the sky. The floating cinders to the west of Sumatra created a layer two feet thick and several miles wide on April 12th, which made it difficult for ships to navigate through.

The darkness occasioned in the daytime by the ashes in Java was so profound, that nothing equal to it was ever witnessed in the darkest night. Although this volcanic dust when it fell was an impalpable powder, it was of considerable weight when compressed, a pint of it weighing twelve ounces and three quarters. "Some of the finest particles," says Mr. Crawfurd, "were transported to the islands of Amboyna and Banda, which last is about 800 miles east from the site of the volcano, although the southeast monsoon was then at its height." They must have been projected, therefore, into the upper regions of the atmosphere, where a counter-current prevailed.

The darkness created during the day by the ash in Java was so intense that nothing like it had ever been seen even in the darkest night. Although this volcanic dust fell as a fine powder, it was quite heavy when packed down, with a pint weighing twelve ounces and three quarters. "Some of the finest particles," says Mr. Crawfurd, "were carried to the islands of Amboyna and Banda, the latter being about 800 miles east of the volcano, even though the southeast monsoon was in full swing." They must have been shot up into the higher layers of the atmosphere, where a counter-current was present.

Along the sea-coast of Sumbawa and the adjacent isles, the sea rose suddenly to the height of from two to twelve feet, a great wave rushing up the estuaries, and then suddenly subsiding. Although the wind at Bima was still during the whole time, the sea rolled in upon the shore, and filled the lower parts of the houses with water a foot deep. Every prow and boat was forced from the anchorage, and driven on shore.

Along the coast of Sumbawa and the nearby islands, the sea suddenly surged to heights ranging from two to twelve feet, with a massive wave rushing up the estuaries and then quickly receding. Even though the wind in Bima was calm throughout this time, the sea crashed onto the shore, flooding the lower levels of the houses with a foot of water. Every boat and vessel was pushed from its mooring and driven ashore.

The town called Tomboro, on the west side of Sumbawa, was overflowed by the sea, which encroached upon the shore so that the water remained permanently eighteen feet deep in places where there was land before. Here we may observe, that the amount of subsidence of land was apparent, in spite of the ashes, which would naturally have caused the limits of the coast to be extended.

The town of Tomboro, located on the west side of Sumbawa, was flooded by the sea, which moved in on the shore, leaving the water consistently eighteen feet deep in spots where land used to be. Here we can see that the land had clearly sunk, even with the ashes that would normally have pushed the coastline further out.

The area over which tremulous noises and other volcanic effects extended, was 1000 English miles in circumference, including the whole of the Molucca Islands, Java, a considerable portion of Celebes, Sumatra, and Borneo. In the island of Amboyna, in the same month and year, the ground opened, threw out water, and then closed again.648

The area affected by shaking noises and other volcanic activity covered a circumference of 1000 miles, including all of the Molucca Islands, Java, a large part of Celebes, Sumatra, and Borneo. On the island of Amboyna, during the same month and year, the ground split open, released water, and then sealed itself again.648

In conclusion, I may remind the reader, that but for the accidental presence of Sir Stamford Raffles, then Governor of Java, we should scarcely have heard in Europe of this tremendous catastrophe. He required all the residents in the various districts under his authority to send in a statement of the circumstances which occurred within their own knowledge; but, valuable as were their communications, they are often calculated to excite rather than to satisfy the curiosity of the geologist. They mention that similar effects, though in a less degree, had, about seven years before, accompanied an eruption of Carang Assam, a volcano in the island of Bali, west of Sumatra; but no particulars of that great catastrophe are recorded.649

In conclusion, I want to remind the reader that if it hadn’t been for the unexpected presence of Sir Stamford Raffles, the Governor of Java, we might not have even heard about this massive disaster in Europe. He asked all the residents in the different districts under his control to submit a report detailing everything they knew about it; however, despite their valuable insights, those reports often raise more questions than they answer for geologists. They mention that similar but less severe effects occurred around seven years earlier during an eruption of Carang Assam, a volcano on the island of Bali, west of Sumatra; however, no details about that major disaster have been documented.649

Caraccas, 1812.—On the 26th of March, 1812, several violent shocks of an earthquake were felt in Caraccas. The surface undulated like a boiling liquid, and terrific sounds were heard underground. The whole 466 city with its splendid churches was in an instant a heap of ruins, under which 10,000 of the inhabitants were buried. On the 5th of April, enormous rocks were detached from the mountains. It was believed that the mountain Silla lost from 300 to 360 feet of its height by subsidence; but this was an opinion not founded on any measurement. On the 27th of April, a volcano in St. Vincent's threw out ashes; and, on the 30th, lava flowed from its crater into the sea, while its explosions were heard at a distance equal to that between Vesuvius and Switzerland, the sound being transmitted, as Humboldt supposes, through the ground. During the earthquake which destroyed Caraccas, an immense quantity of water was thrown out at Valecillo, near Valencia, as also at Porto Cabello, through openings in the earth; and in the Lake Maracaybo the water sank. Humboldt observed that the Cordilleras, composed of gneiss and mica slate, and the country immediately at their feet, were more violently shaken than the plains.650

Caracas, 1812.—On March 26, 1812, several violent shocks of an earthquake were felt in Caracas. The ground moved like boiling liquid, and terrifying sounds erupted from underground. In an instant, the entire city, along with its magnificent churches, turned into a pile of rubble, burying 10,000 residents. On April 5, enormous rocks detached from the mountains. It was thought that the mountain Silla lost between 300 to 360 feet of its height due to subsidence, though this was just an opinion without any measurements to support it. On April 27, a volcano in St. Vincent erupted, releasing ash; and on April 30, lava flowed from its crater into the sea, while its explosions could be heard from a distance comparable to that between Vesuvius and Switzerland, the sound being transmitted, as Humboldt theorized, through the ground. During the earthquake that devastated Caracas, a massive amount of water was expelled at Valecillo, near Valencia, as well as at Porto Cabello, through openings in the earth; and in Lake Maracaibo, the water level dropped. Humboldt noted that the Cordilleras, made of gneiss and mica slate, and the land immediately below them were shaken more violently than the plains.650

South Carolina and New Madrid, Missouri, 1811-12.—Previous to the destruction of La Guayra and Caraccas, in 1812, earthquakes were felt in South Carolina; and the shocks continued till those cities were destroyed. The valley also of the Mississippi, from the village of New Madrid to the mouth of the Ohio in one direction, and to the St. Francis in another, was convulsed in such a degree as to create new lakes and islands. It has been remarked by Humboldt in his Cosmos, that the earthquake of New Madrid presents one of the few examples on record of the incessant quaking of the ground for several successive months far from any volcano. Flint, the geographer, who visited the country seven years after the event, informs us, that a tract of many miles in extent, near the Little Prairie, became covered with water three or four feet deep; and when the water disappeared a stratum of sand was left in its place. Large lakes of twenty miles in extent were formed in the course of an hour, and others were drained. The grave-yard at New Madrid was precipitated into the bed of the Mississippi; and it is stated that the ground whereon the town is built, and the river-bank for fifteen miles above, sank eight feet below their former level.651 The neighboring forest presented for some years afterwards "a singular scene of confusion; the trees standing inclined in every direction, and many having their trunks and branches broken."652

South Carolina and New Madrid, Missouri, 1811-12.—Before the destruction of La Guayra and Caracas in 1812, earthquakes were felt in South Carolina, and the tremors continued until those cities were ruined. The Mississippi valley, stretching from the village of New Madrid to the mouth of the Ohio in one direction, and to the St. Francis in another, shook so violently that new lakes and islands formed. Humboldt noted in his *Cosmos* that the New Madrid earthquake is one of the few recorded instances of the ground shaking continuously for several months far from any volcano. Flint, the geographer who visited the area seven years after the event, reported that a large area near Little Prairie was inundated with water three or four feet deep; when the water receded, a layer of sand was left behind. Huge lakes, stretching twenty miles, formed within an hour, while others were drained. The graveyard in New Madrid was dropped into the Mississippi River, and it's reported that the ground where the town is located, as well as the riverbank for fifteen miles upstream, sank eight feet from their previous level.651 The surrounding forest for years after showed "a strange scene of chaos; the trees leaning in every direction, with many having broken trunks and branches."652

The inhabitants relate that the earth rose in great undulations; and when these reached a certain fearful height, the soil burst, and vast volumes of water, sand, and pit-coal were discharged as high as the tops of the trees. Flint saw hundreds of these deep chasms remaining in an alluvial soil, seven years after. The people in the country, although inexperienced in such convulsions, had remarked that the chasms in the earth were in a direction from S. W. to N. E.; and they accordingly felled the tallest trees, and laying them at right angles to the chasms, 467 stationed themselves upon them. By this invention, when chasms opened more than once under these trees, several persons were prevented from being swallowed up.653 At one period during this earthquake, the ground not far below New Madrid swelled up so as to arrest the Mississippi in its course, and to cause a temporary reflux of its waves. The motion of some of the shocks is described as having been horizontal, and of others perpendicular; and the vertical movement is said to have been much less desolating than the horizontal.

The locals say that the ground rose in large waves, and when these reached a terrifying height, the earth cracked open, releasing huge amounts of water, sand, and coal into the air, as high as the treetops. Flint observed hundreds of these deep cracks left in the soft soil even seven years later. The people in the area, although inexperienced with such events, noticed that the cracks in the ground ran from southwest to northeast; so they cut down the tallest trees and laid them at right angles to the cracks, 467 positioning themselves on them. With this setup, when cracks opened beneath these trees more than once, several people managed to avoid being swallowed up.653 At one point during this earthquake, the ground near New Madrid bulged up so much that it stopped the Mississippi River in its path, causing a temporary backflow of its waters. Some of the tremors were described as horizontal, while others were vertical; and it was said that the vertical movement was much less damaging than the horizontal.

The above account has been reprinted exactly as it appeared in former editions of this work, compiled from the authorities which I have cited; but having more recently (March, 1846) had an opportunity myself of visiting the disturbed region of the Mississippi, and conversing with many eye-witnesses of the catastrophe, I am able to confirm the truth of those statements, and to add some remarks on the present face and features of the country. I skirted, as was before related (p. 270), part of the territory immediately west of New Madrid, called "the sunk country," which was for the first time permanently submerged during the earthquake of 1811-12. It is said to extend along the course of the White Water and its tributaries for a distance of between 70 and 80 miles north and south, and 30 miles east and west. I saw on its borders many full-grown trees still standing leafless, the bottoms of their trunks several feet under water, and a still greater number lying prostrate. An active vegetation of aquatic plants is already beginning to fill up some of the shallows, and the sediment washed in by occasional floods when the Mississippi rises to an extraordinary height contributes to convert the sunk region into marsh and forest land. Even on the dry ground along the confines of the submerged area, I observed in some places that all the trees of prior date to 1811 were dead and leafless, though standing erect and entire. They are supposed to have been killed by the loosening of their roots during the repeated undulations which passed through the ground for three months in succession.

The above account has been reprinted exactly as it appeared in earlier editions of this work, compiled from the sources I’ve cited; however, after recently visiting the troubled region of the Mississippi and speaking with many eyewitnesses of the disaster in March 1846, I can confirm the accuracy of those statements and add some comments on the current state of the area. I traveled along part of the land just west of New Madrid, known as "the sunk country," which was first permanently flooded during the earthquake of 1811-12. It’s said to stretch along the White Water and its tributaries for about 70 to 80 miles north and south, and 30 miles east and west. On its edges, I saw many fully grown trees still standing but leafless, with the bottoms of their trunks several feet underwater, and even more lying flat. A vibrant growth of aquatic plants is already starting to fill some of the shallow spots, and sediment carried in by occasional floods when the Mississippi rises high contributes to transforming the sunken area into marsh and forest land. Even on the dry land along the borders of the submerged region, I noticed that in some places all the trees that were there before 1811 were dead and leafless, although still standing upright and intact. They are assumed to have died due to their roots being loosened during the repeated shaking that went on for three months straight.

Mr. Bringier, an experienced engineer of New Orleans, who was on horseback near New Madrid when some of the severest shocks were experienced, related to me (in 1846), that "as the waves advanced the trees bent down, and the instant afterwards, while recovering their position, they often met those of other trees similarly inclined, so that their branches becoming interlocked, they were prevented from righting themselves again. The transit of the wave through the woods was marked by the crashing noise of countless boughs, first heard on one side and then on the other. At the same time powerful jets of water, mixed with sand, mud, and fragments of coaly matter, were cast up, endangering the lives of both horse and rider."

Mr. Bringier, an experienced engineer from New Orleans, was on horseback near New Madrid when some of the strongest tremors struck. He told me in 1846 that, "as the waves rolled in, the trees bent over, and just after that, as they tried to stand back up, they often collided with other trees that were also leaning, causing their branches to get tangled and preventing them from righting themselves again. The movement of the wave through the woods was marked by the loud noise of countless branches breaking, first heard on one side and then the other. At the same time, powerful jets of water mixed with sand, mud, and bits of coal were shot up, putting both the horse and rider in danger."

I was curious, to ascertain whether any vestiges still remained of these fountains of mud and water, and carefully examined between New 468 Madrid and the Little Prairie several "sink holes," as they are termed. They consist of cavities from 10 to 30 yards in width, and 20 feet or more in depth, and are very conspicuous, interrupting the level surface of a flat alluvial plain. I saw abundance of sand, which some of the present inhabitants saw spouting from these deep holes, also fragments of decayed wood and black bituminous shale, probably drifted down at some former period in the main channel of the Mississippi, from the coal-fields farther north. I also found numerous rents in the soil left by the earthquake, some of them still several feet wide, and a yard or two in depth, although the action of rains, frost, and occasional inundations, and especially the leaves of trees blown into them in countless numbers every autumn, have done much to fill them up. I measured the direction of some of the fissures, which usually varied from 10 to 45 degrees W. of north, and were often parallel to each other; I found, however, a considerable diversity in their direction. Many of them are traceable for half a mile and upwards, but they might easily be mistaken for artificial trenches if resident settlers were not there to assure us that within their recollection they were "as deep as wells." Fragments of coaly shale were strewed along the edges of some of these open fissures, together with white sand, in the same manner as round the "sink holes."654

I was curious to find out if any remnants of these mud and water fountains were still around, so I carefully looked at several "sinkholes" between New Madrid and the Little Prairie. They are cavities ranging from 10 to 30 yards wide and over 20 feet deep, standing out noticeably on the flat alluvial plain. I saw a lot of sand; some of the locals had witnessed it spouting from these deep holes, along with pieces of decayed wood and black bituminous shale, likely carried down from the coal fields further north in the main channel of the Mississippi at some point in the past. I also discovered several cracks in the ground left by the earthquake, some still a few feet wide and one or two yards deep, even though rain, frost, and occasional flooding, along with countless autumn leaves blown into them, have filled them in quite a bit. I measured the direction of some of the fissures, which typically varied from 10 to 45 degrees west of north and were often parallel to each other; however, I found quite a bit of variation in their direction. Many of them can be traced for half a mile or more, but they could easily be mistaken for man-made trenches if not for the local residents confirming that, in their memory, they were "as deep as wells." Pieces of coaly shale were scattered along the edges of some of these open fissures, along with white sand, much like around the "sinkholes."654

Among other monuments of the changes wrought in 1811-12, I explored the bed of the lake called Eulalie, near New Madrid, 300 yards long by 100 yards in width, which was suddenly drained during the earthquake. The parallel fissures by which the waters escaped are not yet entirely closed, and all the trees growing on its bottom were at the time of my visit less than 34 years old. They consisted of cotton-wood, willows, and honey-locust, and other species, differing from those clothing the surrounding higher grounds, which are more elevated by 12 or 15 feet. On them the hickory, the black and white oak, the gum and other trees, many of them of ancient date, were flourishing.

Among other monuments of the

Aleutian Islands, 1806.—In the year 1806, a new island, in the form of a peak, with some low conical hills upon it, is said to have risen from the sea among the Aleutian Islands, east of Kamtschatka. According to Langsdorf,655 it was four geographical miles in circumference; and Von Buch infers from its magnitude, and from its not having again subsided below the level of the sea, that it did not consist merely of ejected matter, but of a solid rock of trachyte upheaved.656 Another extraordinary eruption happened in the spring of the year 1814, in the sea near Unalaschka, in the same archipelago. A new isle was then produced of considerable size, and with a peak three thousand feet high, which remained standing for a year afterwards, though with somewhat diminished height.

Aleutian Islands, 1806.—In 1806, a new island, shaped like a peak and featuring some low conical hills, reportedly emerged from the sea among the Aleutian Islands, east of Kamchatka. According to Langsdorf,655 it had a circumference of four geographical miles; and Von Buch concludes from its size and the fact that it has not sunk back below sea level that it was not just made of ejected material, but comprised solid trachyte rock that was pushed up.656 Another remarkable eruption occurred in the spring of 1814, in the sea near Unalaska, in the same archipelago. A new island of considerable size was formed, featuring a peak that rose three thousand feet high, which stood for a year afterward, albeit with a somewhat reduced height.

Although it is not improbable that earthquakes accompanying these 469 tremendous eruptions may have heaved up part of the bed of the sea, yet the circumstance of the islands not having disappeared like Sabrina (see p. 416), may have arisen from the emission of lava. If Jorullo, for example, in 1759, had risen from a shallow sea to the height of 1600 feet, instead of attaining that elevation above the Mexican plateau, the massive current of basaltic lava which poured out from its crater would have enabled it to withstand, for a long period, the action of a turbulent sea.

Although it's not unlikely that earthquakes accompanying these huge eruptions may have lifted part of the sea bed, the fact that the islands didn't disappear like Sabrina (see p. 416) could be due to the flow of lava. For instance, if Jorullo had emerged from a shallow sea in 1759 to a height of 1600 feet, instead of reaching that elevation above the Mexican plateau, the large flow of basaltic lava that came from its crater would have allowed it to withstand the rough sea for a long time.

Reflections on the earthquakes of the nineteenth century.—We are now about to pass on to the events of the eighteenth century; but before we leave the consideration of those already enumerated, let us pause for a moment, and reflect how many remarkable facts of geological interest are afforded by the earthquakes above described, though they constitute but a small part of the convulsions even of the last forty years. New rocks have risen from the waters; new hot springs have burst out, and the temperature of others has been raised; the coast of Chili has been thrice permanently elevated; a considerable tract in the delta of the Indus has sunk down, and some of its shallow channels have become navigable; an adjoining part of the same district, upwards of fifty miles in length and sixteen in breadth, has been raised about ten feet above its former level; part of the great plain of the Mississippi, for a distance of eighty miles in length by thirty in breadth, has sunk down several feet; the town of Tomboro has been submerged, and twelve thousand of the inhabitants of Sumbawa have been destroyed. Yet, with a knowledge of these terrific catastrophes, witnessed during so brief a period by the present generation, will the geologist declare with perfect composure that the earth has at length settled into a state of repose? Will he continue to assert that the changes of relative level of land and sea, so common in former ages of the world, have now ceased? If, in the face of so many striking facts, he persists in maintaining this favorite dogma, it is in vain to hope that, by accumulating the proofs of similar convulsions during a series of antecedent ages, we shall shake his tenacity of purpose:—

Reflections on the earthquakes of the nineteenth century.—We are about to move on to the events of the eighteenth century; but before we leave the considerations we've outlined, let's take a moment to reflect on how many remarkable geological insights can be drawn from the earthquakes mentioned, even though they are just a small part of the seismic activity from the last forty years. New rocks have emerged from the ocean; new hot springs have erupted, and the temperatures of others have increased; the coast of Chile has been permanently raised three times; a large area in the delta of the Indus has sunk, and some of its shallow channels have become navigable; a neighboring section of the same region, over fifty miles long and sixteen miles wide, has been lifted about ten feet above its previous level; part of the vast plain of the Mississippi, stretching eighty miles long and thirty miles wide, has dropped several feet; the town of Tomboro has been flooded, and twelve thousand people from Sumbawa have lost their lives. Yet, in light of these terrifying events witnessed within such a short time by today’s generation, can the geologist calmly claim that the earth has finally settled into a state of peace? Can he still argue that the changes in the relative levels of land and sea, which were so common in earlier ages, have now come to an end? If, despite such compelling evidence, he insists on holding onto this favored belief, there is little hope that accumulating proof of similar upheavals throughout earlier ages will change his steadfastness:—

If the world should break The ruins will strike unafraid.
EARTHQUAKES OF THE EIGHTEENTH CENTURY.

Quito, 1797.—On the morning of February 4th, 1797, the volcano of Tunguragua in Quito, and the surrounding district, for forty leagues from south to north, and twenty leagues from west to east, experienced an undulating movement, which lasted four minutes. The same shock was felt over a tract of 170 leagues from south to north, from Piura to Popayan; and 140 from west to east, from the sea to the river Napo. In the smaller district first mentioned, where the movement was more intense, every town was levelled to the ground; and Riobamba, Quero, and other places, were buried under masses detached from the mountains. 470 At the foot of Tunguragua the earth was rent open in several places; and streams of water and fetid mud, called "moya," poured out, overflowing and wasting every thing. In valleys 1000 feet broad, the water of these floods reached to the height of 600 feet; and the mud deposit barred up the course of the river, so as to form lakes, which in some places continued for more than eighty days. Flames and suffocating vapors escaped from the lake Quilotoa, and killed all the cattle on its shores. The shocks continued all February and March; and on the 5th of April they recurred with almost as much violence as at first. We are told that the form of the surface in the district most shaken was entirely altered, but no exact measurements are given whereby we may estimate the degree of elevation or subsidence.657 Indeed it would be difficult, except in the immediate neighborhood of the sea, to obtain any certain standard of comparison if the levels were really as much altered as the narrations imply.

Quito, 1797.—On the morning of February 4th, 1797, the Tunguragua volcano in Quito and the nearby area, stretching forty leagues from south to north and twenty leagues from west to east, experienced a series of rolling movements that lasted four minutes. The same tremor was felt over a distance of 170 leagues from Piura to Popayan, and 140 leagues from the ocean to the Napo River. In the smaller area mentioned earlier, where the movement was stronger, every town was destroyed; Riobamba, Quero, and other places were buried under debris that fell from the mountains. 470 At the base of Tunguragua, the ground cracked in several locations, allowing streams of water and foul mud, known as "moya," to pour out, flooding and ruining everything in their path. In valleys that were 1000 feet wide, the water from these floods rose to heights of 600 feet, and the mud buildup blocked the river's flow, creating lakes that lasted in some areas for over eighty days. Flames and suffocating gases erupted from the Quilotoa lake, killing all the livestock on its shores. The tremors continued throughout February and March, and on April 5th, they returned with nearly the same intensity as before. It's reported that the landscape in the most affected area changed completely, but no precise measurements are provided to gauge the extent of elevation or sinking. 657 In fact, it would be challenging, except close to the sea, to find any reliable point of reference if the levels had truly been altered as much as the accounts suggest.

Cumana, 1797.—In the same year, on the 14th of December, the small Antilles experienced subterranean movements, and four-fifths of the town of Cumana was shaken down by a vertical shock. The form of the shoal of Mornerouge, at the mouth of the river Bourdones, was changed by an upheaving of the ground.658

Cumana, 1797.—That year, on December 14th, the small Antilles went through underground tremors, and four-fifths of the town of Cumana was collapsed by a vertical shock. The shape of the shoal of Mornerouge, at the mouth of the Bourdones River, was altered due to a rise in the ground.658

Canada—Quebec, 1791.—We learn from Captain Bayfield's memoirs, that earthquakes are very frequent on the shore of the estuary of the St. Lawrence, of force sufficient at times to split walls and throw down chimneys. Such were the effects experienced in December, 1721, in St. Paul's Bay, about fifty miles N. E. from Quebec; and the inhabitants say, that about every twenty-five years a violent earthquake returns, which lasts forty days. In the History of Canada, it is stated that, in 1663, a tremendous convulsion lasted six months, extending from Quebec to Tadeausac,—a distance of about 130 miles. The ice on the river was broken up, and many landslips caused.659

Canada—Quebec, 1791.—According to Captain Bayfield's memoirs, earthquakes are quite common along the Estuary of the St. Lawrence, sometimes powerful enough to crack walls and topple chimneys. Such effects were felt in December 1721 in St. Paul's Bay, roughly fifty miles northeast of Quebec; locals claim that a strong earthquake occurs about every twenty-five years, lasting for forty days. The History of Canada notes that in 1663, a massive tremor lasted for six months, stretching from Quebec to Tadoussac—a distance of about 130 miles. The ice on the river was shattered, and numerous landslides occurred.659

Caraccas, 1790.—In the Caraccas, near where the Caura joins the Orinoco, between the towns San Pedro de Alcantara and San Francisco de Aripao, an earthquake, on St. Matthew's day 1790, caused a sinking in of the granitic soil, and left a lake 800 yards in diameter, and from eighty to one hundred in depth. It was a portion of the forest of Aripao which subsided, and the trees remained green for several months under water.660

Caraccas, 1790.—In Caraccas, near where the Caura River meets the Orinoco, between the towns of San Pedro de Alcantara and San Francisco de Aripao, an earthquake on St. Matthew's Day in 1790 caused the granitic soil to sink, resulting in a lake that was 800 yards in diameter and between eighty to one hundred feet deep. This area was part of the Aripao forest that subsided, and the trees stayed green for several months while submerged.660

Sicily, 1790.—On the 18th of March in the same year, at S. Maria di Niscemi, some miles from Terranuova, near the south coast of Sicily, the ground gradually sunk down for a circumference of three Italian miles, during seven shocks; and, in one place, to the depth of thirty feet. It continued to subside to the end of the month. Several fissures sent forth sulphur, petroleum, steam, and hot water, and a stream of 471 mud, which flowed for two hours, and covered a space sixty feet long and thirty broad. This happened far from both the ancient and modern volcanic district, in a group of strata consisting chiefly of blue clay.661

Sicily, 1790.—On March 18th of that year, at S. Maria di Niscemi, just a few miles from Terranuova, near the southern coast of Sicily, the ground gradually sank over an area of three Italian miles during seven tremors, reaching a depth of thirty feet in one spot. It continued to sink until the end of the month. Several cracks released sulfur, oil, steam, and hot water, alongside a stream of mud that lasted for two hours and covered an area sixty feet long and thirty feet wide. This occurred far from both the ancient and modern volcanic regions, in a cluster of layers primarily made up of blue clay.471661

Java, 1786.—About the year 1786, an earthquake was felt at intervals, for the period of four months, in the neighborhood of Batur, in Java, and an eruption followed. Various rents were formed, which emitted a sulphurous vapor; separate tracts sunk away, and were swallowed by the earth. Into one of these the rivulet Dotog entered, and afterwards continued to follow a subterraneous course. The village of Jampang was buried in the ground, with thirty-eight of its inhabitants, who had not time to escape. We are indebted to Dr. Horsfield for having verified the above-mentioned facts.662

Java, 1786.—Around 1786, an earthquake was experienced periodically for four months near Batur, Java, and an eruption followed. Various cracks formed that released a sulfurous vapor; some areas sank and were consumed by the earth. One of these cracks was where the Dotog stream flowed in, and it later continued its course underground. The village of Jampang was buried along with thirty-eight of its residents, who didn’t have time to escape. We owe it to Dr. Horsfield for confirming these facts.662


CHAPTER XXVIII.

EARTHQUAKE IN CALABRIA, 1783.

Earthquake in Calabria, February 5, 1783—Shocks continued to the end of the year 1786—Authorities—Area convulsed—Geological structure of the district—Difficulty of ascertaining changes of level—Subsidence of the quay at Messina—Movement in the stones of two obelisks—Shift or fault in the Round Tower of Terranuova—Opening and closing of fissures—Large edifices engulfed—Dimensions of new caverns and fissures—Gradual closing in of rents—Bounding of detached masses into the air—Landslips—Buildings transported entire to great distances—New lakes—Funnel-shaped hollows in alluvial plains—Currents of mud—Fall of cliffs, and shore near Scilla inundated—State of Stromboli and Etna during the shocks—How earthquakes contribute to the formation of valleys—Concluding remarks.

Earthquake in Calabria, February 5, 1783—Shocks continued until the end of 1786—Authorities—Area affected—Geological features of the region—Challenges in determining changes in elevation—Subsidence of the quay at Messina—Movement in the stones of two obelisks—Shift or fault in the Round Tower of Terranuova—Opening and closing of cracks—Large buildings destroyed—Sizes of new caverns and fissures—Gradual closing of gaps—Bouncing of detached masses into the air—Landslides—Buildings moved intact over long distances—New lakes—Funnel-shaped depressions in alluvial plains—Mud flows—Collapse of cliffs, and the shore near Scilla flooded—Condition of Stromboli and Etna during the shocks—How earthquakes help shape valleys—Concluding remarks.

Calabria, 1783.—Of the numerous earthquakes which have occurred in different parts of the globe, during the last 100 years, that of Calabria, in 1783, is almost the only one of which the geologist can be said to have such a circumstantial account as to enable him fully to appreciate the changes which this cause is capable of producing in the lapse of ages. The shocks began in February, 1783, and lasted for nearly four years, to the end of 1786. Neither in duration, nor in violence, nor in the extent of territory moved, was this convulsion remarkable, when contrasted with many experienced in other countries, both during the last and present century; nor were the alterations which it occasioned in the relative level of hill and valley, land and sea, so great as those effected by some subterranean movements in South America, in later times. The importance of the earthquake in question arises from the circumstance, that Calabria is the only spot hitherto visited, both 472 during and after the convulsions, by men possessing sufficient leisure, zeal, and scientific information, to enable them to collect and describe with accuracy the physical facts which throw light on geological questions.

Calabria, 1783.—Out of the many earthquakes that have happened around the world over the last 100 years, the one in Calabria in 1783 is uniquely documented enough for geologists to understand the long-term changes it caused. The tremors started in February 1783 and continued for nearly four years, ending in 1786. In terms of duration, intensity, and the area affected, this earthquake was not as remarkable when compared to others experienced in various countries during the last century and this one; nor were the changes it caused in the relationship between hills and valleys, land and sea, as significant as those from some underground events in South America in more recent times. The significance of the Calabria earthquake lies in the fact that it is the only location so far that has been examined, both during and after the tremors, by people with enough time, enthusiasm, and scientific knowledge to accurately collect and describe the physical facts that shed light on geological issues.

Fig. 74. Map of Calabria.

Authorities.—Among the numerous authorities, Vivenzio, physician to the king of Naples, transmitted to the court a regular statement of his observations during the continuance of the shocks; and his narrative is drawn up with care and clearness.663 Francesco Antonio Grimaldi, then secretary of war, visited the different provinces at the king's command, and published a most detailed description of the permanent changes in the surface.664 He measured the length, breadth, and depth of the different fissures and gulfs which opened, and ascertained their number in many provinces. His comments, moreover, on the reports of the inhabitants, and his explanations of their relations, are judicious and instructive. Pignataro, a physician residing at Monteleone, a town placed in the very centre of the convulsions, kept a register of the shocks, distinguishing them into four classes, according to their degree of violence. From his work, it appears that, in the year 1783, the number was 949, of which 501 were shocks of the first degree of force; 473 and in the following year there were 151, of which 98 were of the first magnitude.

Authorities.—Among the many authorities, Vivenzio, the physician to the king of Naples, sent a detailed report of his observations during the ongoing shocks to the court; his account is carefully and clearly written.663 Francesco Antonio Grimaldi, who was the secretary of war at the time, visited various provinces at the king's request and published a very thorough description of the lasting changes in the landscape.664 He measured the length, width, and depth of the various fissures and openings that appeared and counted their numbers in several provinces. His comments on the residents’ reports, along with his analyses of their implications, are thoughtful and enlightening. Pignataro, a doctor living in Monteleone, a town at the epicenter of the quakes, kept a record of the shocks, categorizing them into four classes based on their severity. From his records, it shows that in 1783, there were 949 shocks, with 501 classified as the first degree of force; 473 and in the following year, there were 151, 98 of which were classified as the first magnitude.

Count Ippolito, also, and many others, wrote descriptions of the earthquake; and the Royal Academy of Naples, not satisfied with these and other observations, sent a deputation from their own body into Calabria, before the shocks had ceased, who were accompanied by artists instructed to illustrate by drawings the physical changes of the district, and the state of ruined towns and edifices. Unfortunately these artists were not very successful in their representations of the condition of the country, particularly when they attempted to express, on a large scale, the extraordinary revolutions which many of the great and minor river-courses underwent. But many of the plates published by the Academy are valuable; and as they are little known, I shall frequently avail myself of them to illustrate the facts about to be described.665

Count Ippolito and many others wrote about the earthquake; and the Royal Academy of Naples, not satisfied with these and other reports, sent a team from their own organization into Calabria while the tremors were still happening. They were accompanied by artists tasked with illustrating the physical changes in the area and the state of the destroyed towns and buildings. Unfortunately, these artists weren’t very successful in capturing the condition of the country, especially when they tried to depict, on a large scale, the dramatic changes many of the major and minor rivers experienced. However, many of the illustrations published by the Academy are valuable, and since they are not widely known, I will often use them to support the facts I’m about to describe.665

In addition to these Neapolitan sources of information, our countryman, Sir William Hamilton, surveyed the district, not without some personal risk, before the shocks had ceased; and his sketch, published in the Philosophical Transactions, supplies many facts that would otherwise have been lost. He has explained, in a rational manner, many events which, as related in the language of some eye-witnesses, appeared marvellous and incredible. Dolomieu also examined Calabria during the catastrophe, and wrote an account of the earthquake, correcting a mistake into which Hamilton had fallen, who supposed that a part of the tract shaken had consisted of volcanic tuff. It is, indeed, a circumstance which enhances the geological interest of the commotions which so often modify the surface of Calabria, that they are confined to a country where there are neither ancient nor modern rocks of volcanic or trappean origin; so that at some future time, when the era of disturbance shall have passed by, the cause of former revolutions will be as latent as in parts of Great Britain now occupied exclusively by ancient marine formations.

In addition to these Neapolitan sources of information, our fellow countryman, Sir William Hamilton, explored the area, not without some personal risk, before the shocks finally stopped; and his report, published in the Philosophical Transactions, provides many details that would have otherwise been lost. He has clarified, in a reasonable way, many events which, as recounted by some eyewitnesses, seemed amazing and unbelievable. Dolomieu also studied Calabria during the disaster and wrote an account of the earthquake, correcting a mistake that Hamilton made, who thought that part of the area affected was made up of volcanic tuff. It is indeed a fact that adds to the geological interest of the disturbances that frequently alter the surface of Calabria, that they occur in a region where there are neither ancient nor modern rocks of volcanic or trappean origin; so that at some future time, when the period of upheaval has passed, the causes of past changes will be as hidden as in parts of Great Britain currently composed solely of ancient marine formations.

Extent of the area convulsed.—The convulsion of the earth, sea, and air extended over the whole of Calabria Ultra, the southeast part of Calabria Citra, and across the sea to Messina and its environs; a district lying between the 38th and 39th degrees of latitude. The concussion was perceptible over a great part of Sicily, and as far north as Naples; but the surface over which the shocks acted so forcibly as to excite intense alarm did not generally exceed 500 square miles in area. The soil of that part of Calabria is composed chiefly, like the southern part of Sicily, of calcareo-argillaceous strata of great thickness, containing marine shells. This clay is sometimes associated with beds of sand and limestone. For the most part these formations resemble in appearance and consistency the Subapennine marls, with their accompanying sands and sandstones; and the whole group bears considerable resemblance, 474 in the yielding nature of its materials, to most of our tertiary deposits in France and England. Chronologically considered, however, the Calabrian formations are comparatively of modern date, often abounding in fossil shells referable to species now living in the Mediterranean.

Extent of the area affected.—The disturbance of the earth, sea, and air spread across all of Calabria Ultra, the southeastern part of Calabria Citra, and across the sea to Messina and its surrounding areas; a region located between the 38th and 39th degrees of latitude. The shock was felt over a large part of Sicily, reaching as far north as Naples; however, the area where the tremors were strong enough to cause significant alarm did not usually exceed 500 square miles. The soil in that part of Calabria mainly consists, like southern Sicily, of thick calcareous clay layers that contain marine shells. This clay is sometimes mixed with layers of sand and limestone. Generally, these formations look and feel similar to the Subapennine marls, along with their associated sands and sandstones; the entire group also shares a notable resemblance, 474 in terms of the pliable nature of its materials, to many of our tertiary deposits found in France and England. However, when considering their chronology, the Calabrian formations are relatively modern, often containing fossil shells that belong to species currently found in the Mediterranean.

We learn from Vivencio, that on the 20th and 26th of March, 1783, earthquakes occurred in the islands of Zante, Cephalonia, and St. Maura; and in the last-mentioned island several public edifices and private houses were overthrown, and many people destroyed.

We learn from Vivencio that on March 20th and 26th, 1783, earthquakes struck the islands of Zante, Cephalonia, and St. Maura. On St. Maura, several public buildings and private homes were destroyed, and many people lost their lives.

If the city of Oppido, in Calabria Ultra, be taken as a centre, and round that centre a circle be described, with a radius of twenty-two miles, this space will comprehend the surface of the country which suffered the greatest alteration, and where all the towns and villages were destroyed. The first shock, of February 5th, 1783, threw down, in two minutes, the greater part of the houses in all the cities, towns, and villages, from the western flanks of the Apennines in Calabria Ultra to Messina in Sicily, and convulsed the whole surface of the country. Another occurred on the 28th of March, with almost equal violence. The granitic chain which passes through Calabria from north to south, and attains the height of many thousand feet, was shaken but slightly by the first shock, but more rudely by some which followed.

If you take the city of Oppido in Calabria Ultra as a center and draw a circle around it with a radius of twenty-two miles, this area will include the parts of the country that were most affected and where all the towns and villages were destroyed. The first earthquake, on February 5th, 1783, caused most of the buildings in all the cities, towns, and villages, from the western slopes of the Apennines in Calabria Ultra to Messina in Sicily, to collapse within two minutes, shaking the entire landscape. Another quake hit on March 28th, with nearly the same intensity. The granite mountain range that runs from north to south through Calabria was only slightly affected by the first quake but was hit harder by subsequent ones.

Some writers have asserted that the wave-like movements which were propagated through the recent strata, from west to east, became very violent when they reached the point of junction with the granite, as if a reaction was produced where the undulatory movement of the soft strata was suddenly arrested by the more solid rocks. But the statement of Dolomieu on this subject is most interesting, and perhaps, in a geological point of view, the most important of all the observations which are recorded.666 The Apennines, he says, which consist in great part of hard and solid granite, with some micaceous and argillaceous schists, form bare mountains with steep sides, and exhibit marks of great degradation. At their base newer strata are seen of sand and clay, mingled with shells; a marine deposit containing such ingredients as would result from the decomposition of granite. The surface of this newer (tertiary) formation constitutes what is called the plain of Calabria—a platform which is flat and level, except where intersected by narrow valleys or ravines, which rivers and torrents have excavated sometimes to the depth of six hundred feet. The sides of these ravines are almost perpendicular; for the superior stratum, being bound together by the roots of trees, prevents the formation of a sloping bank. The usual effect of the earthquake, he continues, was to disconnect all those masses which either had not sufficient bases for their bulk, or which was supported only by lateral adherence. Hence it follows that throughout almost the whole length of the chain, the soil which adhered to the granite at the base of the mountains Caulone, Esope, Sagra, and 475 Aspramonte, slid over the solid and steeply inclined nucleus, and descended somewhat lower, leaving almost uninterruptedly from St. George to beyond St. Christina, a distance of from nine to ten miles, a chasm between the solid granitic nucleus and the sandy soil. Many lands slipping thus were carried to a considerable distance from their former position, so as entirely to cover others; and disputes arose as to whom the property which had thus shifted its place should belong.

Some writers have claimed that the wave-like movements which traveled through the recent layers, from west to east, intensified dramatically when they hit the granite, almost like a reaction occurred when the soft layers’ undulating movement was suddenly stopped by the more solid rocks. Dolomieu's remarks on this topic are particularly intriguing and may, from a geological perspective, be the most significant of all the recorded observations.666 He notes that the Apennines, primarily made up of hard granite along with some micaceous and argillaceous schists, rise as bare mountains with steep slopes and show signs of significant erosion. At their base, newer layers of sand and clay mixed with shells can be seen; these marine deposits contain materials that would result from the weathering of granite. The surface of this newer (tertiary) formation forms what is known as the plain of Calabria—a flat and level platform, except where it is disrupted by narrow valleys or ravines carved out by rivers and torrents, sometimes up to six hundred feet deep. The sides of these ravines are nearly vertical; the upper layer, held together by tree roots, prevents the formation of sloping banks. He goes on to explain that the typical effect of an earthquake is to disconnect all those masses that either lack a solid base for their weight or are only held up by lateral support. As a result, throughout most of the length of the chain, the soil attached to the granite at the base of the mountains Caulone, Esope, Sagra, and 475 Aspramonte slid over the solid, steeply inclined core and moved somewhat lower, creating a nearly uninterrupted gap from St. George to beyond St. Christina, a distance of nine to ten miles, between the solid granitic core and the sandy soil. Many lands slipped in this way were carried a significant distance from their original positions, completely covering others; disputes then arose over the ownership of the property that had shifted its location.

From this account of Dolomieu we might anticipate, as the result of a continuance of such earthquakes, first, a longitudinal valley following the line of junction of the older and newer rocks; secondly, greater disturbance in the newer strata near the point of contact than at a greater distance from the mountains; phenomena very common in other parts of Italy at the junction of the Apennine and Subapennine formations.

From Dolomieu's account, we could expect that if these earthquakes keep happening, first, there would be a long valley along the line where the older and newer rocks meet; second, there would be more disruption in the newer layers close to the point of contact than further away from the mountains; these are phenomena that are quite common in other areas of Italy where the Apennine and Subapennine formations meet.

Mr. Mallet, in his valuable essay on the Dynamics of Earthquakes,667 offers the following explanation of the fact to which Dolomieu has called attention. When a wave of elastic compression, of which he considers the earth-wave to consist, passes abruptly from a body having an extremely low elasticity, such as clay and gravel, into another like granite, whose elasticity is remarkably high, it changes not only its velocity but in part also its course, a portion being reflected and a portion refracted. The wave being thus sent back again produces a shock in the opposite direction, doing great damage to buildings on the surface by thus returning upon itself. At the same time, the shocks are at once eased when they get into the more elastic materials of the granitic mountains.

Mr. Mallet, in his insightful essay on the Dynamics of Earthquakes,667 offers the following explanation of the phenomenon that Dolomieu highlighted. When a wave of elastic compression, which he believes is what makes up the earth-wave, abruptly moves from a material with very low elasticity, like clay and gravel, to one with much higher elasticity, like granite, it not only changes its speed but also its path, with part of the wave being reflected and part refracted. This reflected wave creates a shock in the opposite direction, causing significant damage to buildings on the surface as it bounces back. Meanwhile, the shocks diminish when they reach the more elastic materials of the granitic mountains.

The surface of the country during the Calabrian earthquakes often heaved like the billows of a swelling sea, which produced a swimming in the head, like sea-sickness. It is particularly stated, in almost all the accounts, that just before each shock the clouds appeared motionless; and, although no explanation is offered of this phenomenon, it is obviously the same as that observed in a ship at sea when it pitches violently. The clouds seem arrested in their career as often as the vessel rises in a direction contrary to their course; so that the Calabrians must have experienced precisely the same motion on the land.

The ground in Calabria during the earthquakes often shook like the waves of a rising sea, which caused a dizzy feeling, similar to seasickness. Almost all reports mention that right before each tremor, the clouds looked still; and while no one explains this phenomenon, it clearly resembles what you see on a ship at sea when it rolls violently. The clouds seem to freeze in place whenever the boat tilts against their path; so, the people in Calabria must have felt exactly the same movement on land.

Trees, supported by their trunks, sometimes bent during the shocks to the earth, and touched it with their tops. This is mentioned as a well-known fact by Dolomieu; and he assures us that he was always on his guard against the spirit of exaggeration in which the vulgar are ever ready to indulge when relating these wonderful occurrences.

Trees, supported by their trunks, sometimes bent during the shocks to the ground, and touched it with their tops. This is noted as a well-known fact by Dolomieu; and he assures us that he was always cautious of the exaggeration that people often indulge in when describing these amazing events.

It is impossible to suppose that these waves, which are described in Italy and other regions of earthquakes as passing along the solid surface of the earth in a given direction like a billow on the sea, have any strict analogy with the undulations of a fluid. They are doubtless the effects of vibrations, radiating from some deep-seated point, each of which on reaching the surface lifts up the ground, and then allows it again to subside. As the distance between the source of the subterranean move476ment and the surface must vary according to the outline of the country, so the vibratory jar will reach different points in succession.

It's hard to believe that these waves, which are observed in Italy and other earthquake-prone areas moving along the solid ground in a specific direction like waves on the sea, have a direct comparison with the ripples of a liquid. They are certainly the result of vibrations radiating from some deep-seated point, each of which, upon reaching the surface, raises the ground and then lets it settle back down. Since the distance from the source of the underground movement to the surface varies based on the landscape, the vibratory shock will hit different locations one after another.

Fig. 75.Shifts in the stones of two obelisks in the Convent of St Bruno.

Shifts in the stones of two obelisks in the Convent of St Bruno.

Shifts in the stones of two obelisks at the Convent of St. Bruno.

The Academicians relate that in some of the cities of Calabria effects were produced seeming to indicate a whirling or vorticose movement. Thus, for example, two obelisks (fig. 75) placed at the extremities of a magnificent façade in the convent of S. Bruno, in a small town called Stefano del Bosco, were observed to have undergone a movement of a singular kind. The shock which agitated the building is described as having been horizontal and vorticose. The pedestal of each obelisk remained in its original place; but the separate stones above were turned partially round, and removed sometimes nine inches from their position without falling.

The academics report that in some cities of Calabria, strange effects occurred that seemed to show a swirling or vortex-like movement. For instance, two obelisks (fig. 75) positioned at either end of a stunning facade in the convent of S. Bruno, in a small town called Stefano del Bosco, were noted to have moved in a unique way. The tremor that shook the building is described as being horizontal and vortex-like. The base of each obelisk stayed where it was, but the individual stones above turned partially and shifted as much as nine inches from their original positions without toppling over.

It has been suggested by Mr. Darwin that this kind of displacement may be due to a vibratory rather than a whirling motion;668 and more lately Mr. Mallet, in the paper already cited, has offered a very ingenious solution of the problem. He refers the twisting simply to an elastic wave, which has moved the pedestal forwards and back again, by an alternate horizontal motion within narrow limits, and he has succeeded in showing that a rectilinear movement in the ground may have sufficed to cause an incumbent body to turn partially round upon its bed, provided a certain relation exist between the position of the centre of gravity of the body and its centre of adherence.669

It has been suggested by Mr. Darwin that this kind of displacement might be due to a vibrating motion rather than a whirling one;668 and more recently, Mr. Mallet, in the previously mentioned paper, has provided a very clever solution to the problem. He attributes the twisting simply to an elastic wave, which has moved the pedestal back and forth through an alternating horizontal motion within narrow limits. He has demonstrated that a straight movement in the ground could be enough to make an object turn partially on its base, given that a certain relationship exists between the position of the object's center of gravity and its center of adherence.669

I shall now consider, in the first place, that class of physical changes produced by the earthquake which are connected with alterations in the relative level of the different parts of the land; and afterwards describe those which are more immediately connected with the derangement of the regular drainage of the country, and where the force of running water co-operated with that of the earthquake.

I will first discuss the kinds of physical changes caused by the earthquake that relate to shifts in the relative levels of different areas of land. Then, I will describe those changes that are more directly associated with disruptions in the regular drainage of the region, particularly where the force of flowing water worked alongside the earthquake.

Difficulty of ascertaining changes of level.—In regard to alterations of 477relative level, none of the accounts establish that they were on a considerable scale; but it must always be remembered that, in proportion to the area moved is the difficulty of proving that the general level has undergone any change, unless the sea-coast happens to have participated in the principal movement. Even then it is often impossible to determine whether an elevation or depression even of several feet has occurred, because there is nothing to attract notice in a band of shingle and sand of unequal breadth above the level of the sea running parallel to a coast; such bands generally marking the point reached by the waves during spring tides, or the most violent tempests. The scientific investigator has not sufficient topographical knowledge to discover whether the extent of beach has diminished or increased; and he who has the necessary local information, scarcely ever feels any interest in ascertaining the amount of the rise or fall of the ground. Add to this the great difficulty of making correct observations, in consequence of the enormous waves which roll in upon a coast during an earthquake, and efface every landmark near the shore.

Difficulty of determining changes in elevation.—When it comes to changes in relative elevation, none of the reports indicate that they occurred on a large scale; however, it's important to note that the larger the area affected, the harder it is to prove that the overall level has changed, unless the coastline was part of the main movement. Even then, it can be challenging to tell whether an uplift or drop of several feet has taken place, because nothing stands out in a stretch of pebbles and sand of varying width above sea level running alongside the coast; these stretches typically mark the furthest point reached by waves during spring tides or severe storms. The scientific investigator often lacks enough topographical knowledge to determine if the beach area has lessened or increased; and those who do have the necessary local insight rarely care to find out the extent of the rise or fall of the land. Moreover, the huge waves crashing on the coast during an earthquake make it very difficult to collect accurate observations, as they can wash away all the landmarks near the shore.

Subsidence of the quay at Messina.—It is evidently in seaports alone that we can look for very accurate indications of slight changes of level; and when we find them, we may presume that they would not be rare at other points, if equal facilities of comparing relative altitudes were afforded. Grimaldi states (and his account is confirmed by Hamilton and others), that at Messina, in Sicily, the shore was rent; and the soil along the port, which before the shock was perfectly level, was found afterwards to be inclined towards the sea,—the sea itself near the "Banchina" becoming deeper, and its bottom in several places disordered. The quay also sunk down about fourteen inches below the level of the sea, and the houses in its vicinity were much fissured. (Phil. Trans. 1783.)

Subsidence of the quay at Messina.—It’s clear that we can find very precise evidence of slight changes in level only in seaports; and when we do find such evidence, we can assume they probably occur elsewhere too, if we had the same ability to compare relative altitudes. Grimaldi reports (and this has been backed up by Hamilton and others) that at Messina, Sicily, the shoreline was torn apart; and the ground along the port, which was perfectly level before the shock, was later found to slope toward the sea—the sea itself near the "Banchina" becoming deeper and its bottom disturbed in several spots. The quay also sank about fourteen inches below sea level, and the nearby houses were significantly cracked. (Phil. Trans. 1783.)

Among various proofs of partial elevation and depression in the interior, the Academicians mention, in their Survey, that the ground was sometimes on the same level on both sides of new ravines and fissures, but sometimes there had been a considerable shifting, either by the upheaving of one side, or the subsidence of the other. Thus, on the sides of long rents in the territory of Soriano, the stratified masses had altered their relative position to the extent of from eight to fourteen palms (six to ten and a half feet).

Among the various signs of partial rising and sinking inside the earth, the Academicians note in their Survey that the ground was occasionally level on both sides of new ravines and cracks, but at other times, there was a significant shift, either due to one side being pushed up or the other side sinking down. For example, along the long cracks in the Soriano area, the layers of rock had changed their relative position by as much as eight to fourteen palms (six to ten and a half feet).

Polistena.—Similar shifts in the strata are alluded to in the territory of Polistena, where there appeared innumerable fissures in the earth. One of these was of great length and depth; and in parts the level of the corresponding sides was greatly changed. (See fig. 76.)

Polistena.—Similar changes in the layers are mentioned in the area of Polistena, where countless cracks appeared in the ground. One of these cracks was very long and deep; and in some sections, the height of the surrounding sides was significantly altered. (See fig. 76.)

Terranuova.—In the town of Terranuova some houses were seen uplifted above the common level, and others adjoining sunk down into the earth. In several streets the soil appeared thrust up, and abutted against the walls of houses: a large circular tower of solid masonry, part of which had withstood the general destruction, was divided by a vertical rent, and one side was upraised, and the foundations heaved out of the ground. It was compared by the Academicians to a great tooth 478 half extracted from the alveolus, with the upper part of the fangs exposed. (See fig. 77.)

Terranuova.—In the town of Terranuova, some houses were elevated above the usual level, while others nearby were sunken into the ground. In several streets, the soil was pushed up and pressed against the house walls. A large circular tower made of solid stone, part of which had survived the overall destruction, had a vertical crack, with one side lifted and its foundations pushed up out of the ground. The Academicians compared it to a large tooth that was half pulled from its socket, with the upper part of the tooth exposed. 478 (See fig. 77.)

Fig. 76.Deep fissure, near Polistena, caused by the earthquake of 1783.

Deep fissure, near Polistena, caused by the earthquake of 1783.

Deep crack, near Polistena, caused by the earthquake in 1783.

Along the line of this shift, or "fault," as it would be termed technically by miners, the walls were found to adhere firmly to each other, and to fit so well, that the only signs of their having been disunited was the want of correspondence in the courses of stone on either side of the rent.

Along this shift, or "fault," as miners would technically call it, the walls were found to stick together tightly and fit so perfectly that the only indication they had been separated was the lack of alignment in the stone patterns on either side of the gap.

Fig. 77.Shift or fault in the Round Tower of Terranuova in Calabria.

Shift or "fault" in the Round Tower of Terranuova in Calabria, occasioned by the earthquake of 1783.

Shift or "fault" in the Round Tower of Terranuova in Calabria, caused by the earthquake of 1783.

Dolomieu saw a stone well in the convent of the Augustins at Terranuova, which had the appearance of having been driven out of the earth. It resembled a small tower eight or nine feet in height, and a little inclined. This effect, he says, was produced by the consolidation and consequent sinking of the sandy soil in which the well was dug.

Dolomieu saw a stone well at the Augustinian convent in Terranuova, which looked like it had been pushed up from the ground. It was like a small tower, about eight or nine feet tall, and slightly tilted. He mentioned that this effect was caused by the solidification and subsequent sinking of the sandy soil where the well was excavated.

479 In some walls which had been thrown down, or violently shaken, in Monteleone, the separate stones were parted from the mortar, so as to leave an exact mould where they had rested; whereas in other cases the mortar was ground to dust between the stones.

479 In some walls that had been knocked down or violently shaken in Monteleone, the individual stones were separated from the mortar, creating a perfect imprint where they had been; while in other instances, the mortar was reduced to dust between the stones.

It appears that the wave-like motions often produced effects of the most capricious kind. Thus, in some streets of Monteleone, every house was thrown down but one; in others, all but two; and the buildings which were spared were often scarcely in the least degree injured. In many cities of Calabria, all the most solid buildings were thrown down, while those which were slightly built escaped; but at Rosarno, as also at Messina in Sicily, it was precisely the reverse, the massive edifices being the only ones that stood.

It seems that the wave-like movements often had unpredictable effects. In some streets of Monteleone, every house was destroyed except for one; in others, all but two were affected, and the buildings that survived were often barely damaged. In many cities in Calabria, all the strongest buildings came down, while those that were poorly constructed remained intact. However, in Rosarno, as well as in Messina in Sicily, it was the opposite; the sturdy buildings were the only ones that survived.

Fissures.—It appears evident that a great part of the rending and fissuring of the ground was the effect of a violent motion from below upwards; and in a multitude of cases where the rents and chasms opened and closed alternately, we must suppose that the earth was by turns heaved up, and then let fall again.670 We may conceive the same effect to be produced on a small scale, if, by some mechanical force, a pavement composed of large flags of stone should be raised up, and then allowed to fall suddenly, so as to resume its original position. If any small pebbles happened to be lying on the line of contact of two flags, they would fall into the opening when the pavement rose, and be swallowed up, so that no trace of them would appear after the subsidence of the stones. In the same manner, when the earth was upheaved, large houses, trees, cattle, and men were engulfed in an instant in chasms and fissures; and when the ground sank down again, the earth closed upon them, so that no vestige of them was discoverable on the surface. In many instances, individuals were swallowed up by one shock, and then thrown out again alive, together with large jets of water, by the shock which immediately succeeded.

Fissures.—It seems clear that much of the cracking and splitting of the ground resulted from a powerful movement from below pushing upward; and in many cases where the cracks and gaps opened and closed alternately, we must assume that the earth was pushed up and then dropped back down again.670 We can imagine a similar effect happening on a smaller scale if, through some mechanical force, a pavement made of large stone slabs were lifted and then suddenly dropped, returning to its original position. If any small pebbles were resting on the edge where two slabs met, they would fall into the gap when the pavement rose and be swallowed up, leaving no trace after the stones settled back down. Similarly, when the earth was raised, large buildings, trees, livestock, and people were swallowed in an instant by the cracks and fissures; and when the ground sank again, it closed upon them, so that no sign of them was found on the surface. In many cases, people were consumed by one tremor and then expelled alive, along with huge bursts of water, by the tremor that followed.

Fig. 78.Fissures near Jerocarne, in Calabria, caused by the earthquake of 1783.

Fissures near Jerocarne, in Calabria, caused by the earthquake of 1783.

Fissures near Jerocarne, in Calabria, caused by the earthquake in 1783.

480 At Jerocarne, a country which, according to the Academicians, was lacerated in a most extraordinary manner, the fissures ran in every direction, "like cracks on a broken pane of glass" (see fig. 78); and as a great portion of them remained open after the shocks, it is very possible that this country was permanently upraised. It was usual, as we learn from Dolomieu, for the chasms and fissures throughout Calabria, to ran parallel to the course of some pre-existing gorges in their neighborhood.

480 In Jerocarne, a region that the Academicians described as being badly damaged in a very unusual way, the cracks spread out in every direction, "like cracks on a broken pane of glass" (see fig. 78); and since many of them stayed open after the shocks, it’s quite possible that this area was permanently lifted. According to Dolomieu, it was common for the chasms and cracks throughout Calabria to run parallel to the nearby existing gorges.

Houses engulfed.—In the vicinity of Oppido, the central point from which the earthquake diffused its violent movements, many houses were swallowed up by the yawning earth, which closed immediately over them. In the adjacent district, also, of Cannamaria four farm-houses, several oil-stores, and some spacious dwelling-houses were so completely engulfed in one chasm, that not a vestige of them was afterwards discernible. The same phenomena occurred at Terranuova, S. Christina, and Sinopoli. The Academicians state particularly, that when deep abysses had opened in the argillaceous strata of Terranuova, and houses had sunk into them, the sides of the chasms closed with such violence, that, on excavating afterwards to recover articles of value, the workmen found the contents and detached parts of the buildings jammed together so as to become one compact mass. It is unnecessary to accumulate examples of similar occurrences; but so many are well authenticated during this earthquake in Calabria, that we may, without hesitation, yield assent to the accounts of catastrophes of the same kind repeated again and again in history, where whole towns are declared to have been engulfed, and nothing but a pool of water or tract of sand left in their place.

Houses swallowed up.—Near Oppido, the central point from which the earthquake spread its violent shakes, many houses were taken by the gaping earth, which closed right over them. In the nearby area of Cannamaria, four farmhouses, several oil storages, and a few large homes were so completely swallowed in one big pit that there was no trace of them left afterwards. The same thing happened in Terranuova, S. Christina, and Sinopoli. The Academicians specifically note that when deep pits opened in the clay layers of Terranuova, and houses fell into them, the sides of the pits closed so violently that when workers later dug to retrieve valuable items, they found the belongings and parts of the buildings smashed together into one solid mass. There’s no need to keep adding examples of similar events; so many are well-documented during this earthquake in Calabria that we can confidently accept reports of similar disasters throughout history, where entire towns are said to have vanished, leaving only a body of water or a stretch of sand in their place.

Chasm formed near Oppido.—On the sloping side of a hill near Oppido a great chasm opened; and, although a large quantity of soil was precipitated into the abyss, together with a considerable number of olive-trees and part of a vineyard, a great gulf remained after the shock, in the form of an amphitheatre, 500 feet long and 200 feet deep. (See fig. 79.)

Chasm formed near Oppido.—On the hillside near Oppido, a massive chasm opened up; and even though a lot of soil fell into the void, along with several olive trees and part of a vineyard, a large gap remained after the disturbance, shaped like an amphitheater, 500 feet long and 200 feet deep. (See fig. 79.)

Fig. 79.Chasm formed by the earthquake of 1783, near Oppido in Calabria.

Chasm formed by the earthquake of 1783, near Oppido in Calabria.

Chasm created by the earthquake of 1783, near Oppido in Calabria.

481 Dimensions of new fissures and chasms.—According to Grimaldi, many fissures and chasms, formed by the first shock of February 5th, were greatly widened, lengthened, and deepened by the violent convulsions of March 28th. In the territory of San Fili this observer found a new ravine, half a mile in length, two feet and a half broad, and twenty-five feet deep; and another of similar dimensions in the territory of Rosarno. A ravine nearly a mile long, 105 feet broad and thirty feet deep, opened in the district of Plaisano, where, also, two gulfs were caused—one in a place called Cerzulle, three-quarters of a mile long, 150 feet broad, and above one hundred feet deep; and another at La Fortuna, nearly a quarter of a mile long, above thirty feet in breadth, and no less than 225 feet deep.

481 Dimensions of new fissures and chasms.—According to Grimaldi, many fissures and chasms formed by the initial shock on February 5th were significantly widened, lengthened, and deepened by the violent tremors on March 28th. In the San Fili area, this observer found a new ravine measuring half a mile long, two and a half feet wide, and twenty-five feet deep, along with another of similar size in the Rosarno area. A ravine nearly a mile long, 105 feet wide, and thirty feet deep, opened up in the Plaisano district, where two gulfs were also created—one in a place called Cerzulle, three-quarters of a mile long, 150 feet wide, and over one hundred feet deep; and another at La Fortuna, nearly a quarter of a mile long, over thirty feet wide, and a staggering 225 feet deep.

Fig. 80.Chasm in the hill of St. Angelo, near Soriano, in Calabria, caused by the earthquake of 1783.

Chasm in the hill of St. Angelo, near Soriano, in Calabria, caused by the earthquake of 1783.

Chasm in the hill of St. Angelo, near Soriano, in Calabria, caused by the earthquake of 1783.

In the district of Fosolano three gulfs opened: one of these measured 300 feet square, and above thirty feet deep; another was nearly half a mile long, fifteen feet broad, and above thirty-feet deep; the third was 750 feet square. Lastly, a calcareous mountain, called Zefirio, at the southern extremity of the Italian peninsula, was cleft in two for the length of nearly half a mile, and an irregular breadth of many feet. Some of these chasms were in the form of a crescent. The annexed cut (fig. 80) represents one by no means remarkable for its dimensions, which remained open by the side of a small pass over the hill of St. Angelo, near Soriano. The small river Mesima is seen in the foreground.

In the district of Fosolano, three gulfs formed: one was 300 square feet and over thirty feet deep; another was nearly half a mile long, fifteen feet wide, and over thirty feet deep; the third was 750 square feet. Additionally, a limestone mountain called Zefirio, at the southern tip of the Italian peninsula, was split in two for nearly half a mile, with varying widths. Some of these gaps were crescent-shaped. The attached image (fig. 80) shows one that is not particularly notable for its size, which remained open next to a small path over the hill of St. Angelo, near Soriano. The small river Mesima can be seen in the foreground.

Formation of circular hollows and new lakes.—In the report of the Academy, we find that some plains were covered with circular hollows, for the most part about the size of carriage-wheels, but often somewhat larger or smaller. When filled with water to within a foot or two of the surface, they appeared like wells; but, in general, they were filled with dry sand, sometimes with a concave surface, and at other times convex. (See fig. 81.) On digging down, they found them to be funnel 482 shaped, and the moist loose sand in the centre marked the tube up which the water spouted. The annexed cut (fig. 82) represents a section of one of these inverted cones when the water had disappeared, and nothing but dry micaceous sand remained.

Formation of circular hollows and new lakes.—In the Academy's report, we learned that some plains were dotted with circular depressions, mostly about the size of carriage wheels, though often somewhat larger or smaller. When filled with water a foot or two from the top, they looked like wells; however, generally, they were filled with dry sand, sometimes having a concave surface and other times a convex one. (See fig. 81.) When they dug down, they found these hollows to be funnel-shaped, with moist loose sand in the center indicating the tube through which the water flowed. The attached illustration (fig. 82) shows a cross-section of one of these inverted cones once the water had drained away, leaving only dry micaceous sand.

Fig. 81.Circular hollows in the plain of Rosarno, formed by the earthquake of 1783.

Circular hollows in the plain of Rosarno, formed by the earthquake of 1783.

Circular depressions in the Rosarno plain, created by the earthquake in 1783.


Fig. 82.Section of one of the circular hollows formed in the plain of Rosarno.

Section of one of the circular hollows formed in the plain of Rosarno.

Section of one of the circular depressions found in the Rosarno plain.

A small circular pond of similar character was formed not far from Polistena (see fig. 83); and in the vicinity of Seminara, a lake was suddenly caused by the opening of a great chasm, from the bottom of which water issued. This lake was called Lago del Tolfilo. It extended 1785 feet in length, by 937 in breadth, and 52 in depth. The inhabitants, dreading the miasma of this stagnant pool, endeavored, at great cost, to drain it by canals, but without success, as it was fed by springs issuing from the bottom of the deep chasm.

A small circular pond of a similar nature was created not far from Polistena (see fig. 83); and near Seminara, a lake suddenly formed due to the opening of a large chasm, from which water flowed. This lake was named Lago del Tolfilo. It measured 1,785 feet in length, 937 feet in width, and 52 feet in depth. The locals, fearing the unhealthy miasma coming from this stagnant body of water, tried at great expense to drain it with canals, but they were unsuccessful since it was fed by springs coming from the bottom of the deep chasm.

Vivenzio states, that near Sitizzano a valley was nearly filled up to a level with the high grounds on each side, by the enormous masses detached 483 from the boundary hills, and cast down into the course of two streams. By this barrier a lake was formed of great depth, about two miles long and a mile broad. The same author mentions that, upon the whole, there were fifty lakes occasioned during the convulsions: and he assigns localities to all of these. The government surveyors enumerated 215 lakes; but they included in this number many small ponds.

Vivenzio states that near Sitizzano, a valley was nearly filled up to the level of the high ground on either side by the massive chunks that broke off from the boundary hills and fell into the paths of two streams. This created a deep lake that was about two miles long and a mile wide. The same author notes that, overall, there were fifty lakes formed during the upheavals, and he provides locations for all of these. The government surveyors listed 215 lakes, but their count included many small ponds.

Fig. 83.Circular pond near Polistena, in Calabria, caused by the earthquake in 1783.

Circular pond near Polistena, in Calabria, caused by the earthquake in 1783.

Circular pond near Polistena, Calabria, created by the earthquake in 1783.

Cones of sand thrown up.—Many of the appearances exhibited in the alluvial plains, such as springs spouting up their water like fountains at the moment of the shock, have been supposed to indicate the alternate rising and sinking of the ground. The first effect of the more violent shocks was usually to dry up the rivers, but they immediately afterwards overflowed their banks. In marshy places, an immense number of cones of sand were thrown up. These appearances Hamilton explains, by supposing that the first movement raised the fissured plain from below upwards, so that the rivers and stagnant waters in bogs sank down, or at least were not upraised with the soil. But when the ground returned with violence to its former position, the water was thrown up in jets through fissures.671

Cones of sand thrown up.—Many of the things seen in the alluvial plains, like springs shooting up water like fountains during the shock, have been thought to show the ground rising and falling alternately. The first effect of the stronger shocks was usually to dry up the rivers, but they quickly overflowed their banks afterward. In marshy areas, a huge number of cones of sand were created. Hamilton explains these occurrences by suggesting that the initial movement lifted the cracked plain from below, causing the rivers and stagnant waters in swamps to sink or at least not rise with the soil. But when the ground violently returned to its original position, the water was shot up in jets through the cracks.671

The phenomenon, according to Mr. Mallet, may be simply an accident contingent on the principal cause of disturbance, the rapid transit of the earth-wave. "The sources," he says, "of copious springs usually lie in flat plates or fissures filled with water, whether issuing from solid rock, or from loose materials; now, if a vein, or thin flat cavity filled with water, be in such a position that the plane of the plate of water or fissure be transverse to the line of transit of the earth-wave, the effect of the arrival of the earth-wave at the watery fissure will be, at the instant, to compress its walls more or less together, and so squeeze out the water, which will, for a moment, gush up at the spring-head like a fountain, and again remain in repose after the transit of the wave."

The phenomenon, according to Mr. Mallet, might just be an accident related to the main cause of disturbance, which is the rapid movement of the earth-wave. "The sources," he explains, "of abundant springs are usually found in flat plates or cracks filled with water, whether they come from solid rock or loose materials. Now, if a vein or thin flat space filled with water is positioned so that the plane of the water plate or crack is perpendicular to the path of the earth-wave, the impact of the earth-wave reaching the water-filled crack will compress its walls together, squeezing the water out, which will then shoot up at the spring-head like a fountain, before settling down again after the wave has passed."

Gradual closing in of fissures.—Sir W. Hamilton was shown several 484 deep fissures in the vicinity of Mileto, which, although not one of them was above a foot in breadth, had opened so wide during the earthquake as to swallow an ox and nearly one hundred goats. The Academicians also found, on their return through districts which they had passed at the commencement of their tour, that many rents had, in that short interval, gradually closed in, so that their width had diminished several feet, and the opposite walls had sometimes nearly met. It is natural that this should happen in argillaceous strata, while, in more solid rocks, we may expect that fissures will remain open for ages. Should this be ascertained to be a general fact in countries convulsed by earthquakes, it may afford a satisfactory explanation of a common phenomenon in mineral veins. Such veins often retain their full size so long as the rocks consist of limestone, granite, or other indurated materials; but they contract their dimensions, become mere threads, or are even entirely cut off, where masses of an argillaceous nature are interposed. If we suppose the filling up of fissures with metallic and other ingredients to be a process requiring ages for its completion, it is obvious that the opposite walls of rents, where strata consist of yielding materials, must collapse or approach very near to each other before sufficient time is allowed for the accretion of a large quantity of veinstone.

Gradual closing in of fissures.—Sir W. Hamilton was shown several 484 deep fissures near Mileto, which, even though none were wider than a foot, had opened so wide during the earthquake that they swallowed an ox and nearly one hundred goats. The Academicians also found, upon returning through areas they had visited at the start of their trip, that many cracks had gradually closed up in that short time, reducing their width by several feet, with the opposing walls nearly touching at times. It's natural for this to happen in clay-rich layers, while in more solid rocks, we can expect that fissures will stay open for ages. If this is confirmed as a general fact in areas affected by earthquakes, it could provide a clear explanation for a common occurrence in mineral veins. These veins often maintain their full size as long as the rocks are made up of limestone, granite, or other hard materials; however, they shrink down to mere threads or get completely cut off when clay-rich materials are in between. If we assume that filling in fissures with metal and other substances takes ages to complete, it becomes clear that the opposite sides of cracks in yielding materials must collapse or get very close to each other before enough time passes for a large amount of veinstone to accumulate.

Thermal waters augmented.—It is stated by Grimaldi, that the thermal waters of St. Eufemia, in Terra di Amato, which first burst out during the earthquake of 1638, acquired, in February, 1783, an augmentation both in quantity and degree of heat. This fact appears to indicate a connection between the heat of the interior and the fissures caused by the Calabrian earthquakes, notwithstanding the absence of volcanic rocks, either ancient or modern, in that district.

Thermal waters increased.—Grimaldi notes that the thermal waters of St. Eufemia, in Terra di Amato, which first emerged during the earthquake of 1638, experienced a rise in both quantity and temperature in February 1783. This seems to suggest a link between the heat from below the surface and the cracks caused by the Calabrian earthquakes, even though there are no volcanic rocks, either ancient or recent, in that area.

Bounding of detached masses into the air.—The violence of the movement of the ground upwards was singularly illustrated by what the Academicians call the "sbalzo," or bounding into the air, to the height of several yards, of masses slightly adhering to the surface. In some towns a great part of the pavement stones were thrown up, and found lying with their lower sides uppermost. In these cases, we must suppose that they were propelled upwards by the momentum which they had acquired; and that the adhesion of one end of the mass being greater than that of the other, a rotatory motion had been communicated to them. When the stone was projected to a sufficient height to perform somewhat more than a quarter of a revolution in the air, it pitched down on its edge, and fell with its lower side uppermost.

Bouncing of detached masses into the air.—The intense upward movement of the ground was clearly shown by what the Academicians call the "sbalzo," or bouncing into the air, to heights of several yards, of masses that were only slightly stuck to the surface. In some towns, a large number of the pavement stones were thrown up and found lying with their underside facing up. In these instances, we can assume that they were pushed upward by the momentum they gained, and that since one end of the mass stuck better than the other, a spinning motion was transferred to them. When the stone was thrown high enough to make more than a quarter turn in the air, it dropped onto its edge and landed with its underside facing up.

Effects of earthquakes on the excavations of valleys.—The next class of effects to be considered, are those more immediately connected with the formation of valleys, in which the action of water was often combined with that of the earthquake. The country agitated was composed, as before stated, chiefly of argillaceous strata, intersected by deep narrow valleys, sometimes from 500 to 600 feet deep. As the boundary cliffs were in great part vertical, it will readily be conceived that, amidst the various movements of the earth, the precipices overhanging rivers, being 485 without support on one side, were often thrown down. We find, indeed, that inundations produced by obstructions in river-courses are among the most disastrous consequences of great earthquakes in all parts of the world, for the alluvial plains in the bottoms of valleys are usually the most fertile and well-peopled parts of the whole country; and whether the site of a town is above or below a temporary barrier in the channel of a river, it is exposed to injury by the waters either of a lake or flood.

Effects of earthquakes on the excavations of valleys.—The next category of effects to discuss involves those directly related to the formation of valleys, where the action of water often worked alongside that of the earthquake. The affected land was mainly made up of clay-rich layers, crisscrossed by deep and narrow valleys, sometimes reaching depths of 500 to 600 feet. Since the surrounding cliffs were mostly vertical, it's easy to understand that, during various earth movements, the cliffs overhanging rivers, lacking support on one side, frequently collapsed. Indeed, we find that flooding caused by blockages in river paths is one of the most catastrophic results of major earthquakes worldwide, as the alluvial plains at the bottoms of valleys are typically the most fertile and densely populated areas in the country. Whether a town is situated above or below a temporary obstruction in a river's channel, it risks damage from the waters of either a lake or flood.

Landslips.—From each side of the deep valley or ravine of Terranuova enormous masses of the adjoining flat country were detached, and cast down into the course of the river, so as to give rise to great lakes. Oaks, olive-trees, vineyards, and corn, were often seen growing at the bottom of the ravine, as little injured as their former companions, which still continued to flourish in the plain above, at least 500 feet higher, and at the distance of about three-quarters of a mile. In one part of this ravine was an enormous mass, 200 feet high and about 400 feet at its base, which had been detached by some former earthquake. It is well attested, that this mass travelled down the ravine nearly four miles, having been put in motion by the earthquake of the 5th of February. Hamilton, after examining the spot, declared that this phenomenon might be accounted for by the declivity of the valley, the great abundance of rain which fell, and the great weight of the alluvial matter which pressed behind it. Dolomieu also alludes to the fresh impulse derived from other masses falling, and pressing upon the rear of those first set in motion.

Landslips.—On either side of the deep valley or ravine of Terranuova, huge chunks of the surrounding flat land were dislodged and fell into the river, creating large lakes. Oaks, olive trees, vineyards, and grains often thrived at the bottom of the ravine, just as undamaged as their counterparts that continued to grow in the plain above, which was at least 500 feet higher and approximately three-quarters of a mile away. In one section of this ravine, there was a massive block, 200 feet high and about 400 feet wide at its base, that had been dislodged by a previous earthquake. It's well documented that this block traveled down the ravine for nearly four miles, having been set in motion by the earthquake of February 5th. After inspecting the site, Hamilton stated that this phenomenon could be explained by the slope of the valley, the heavy rainfall, and the significant weight of the alluvial material pushing from behind. Dolomieu also noted the additional force derived from other masses falling and pressing on the back of those initially set in motion.

The first account sent to Naples of the two great slides or landslips above alluded to, which caused a great lake near Terranuova, was couched in these words:—"Two mountains on the opposite sides of a valley walked from their original position until they met in the middle of the plain, and there joining together, they intercepted the course of a river," &c. The expressions here used resemble singularly those applied to phenomena, probably very analogous, which are said to have occurred at Fez, during the great Lisbon earthquake, as also in Jamaica and Java at other periods.

The first report sent to Naples about the two major landslides mentioned earlier, which created a large lake near Terranuova, said: “Two mountains on opposite sides of a valley moved from their original positions until they met in the middle of the plain, and there, coming together, they blocked the flow of a river,” etc. The wording used here is strikingly similar to descriptions of similar phenomena that reportedly happened in Fez during the great Lisbon earthquake, as well as in Jamaica and Java at different times.

Not far from Soriano, which was levelled to the ground by the great shock of February, a small valley, containing a beautiful olive-grove, called Fra Ramondo, underwent a most extraordinary revolution. Innumerable fissures first traversed the river-plain in all directions, and absorbed the water until the argillaceous substratum became soaked, so that a great part of it was reduced to a state of fluid paste. Strange alterations in the outline of the ground were the consequence, as the soil to a great depth was easily moulded into any form. In addition to this change, the ruins of the neighboring hills were precipitated into the hollow; and while many olives were uprooted, others remained growing on the fallen masses, and inclined at various angles (see fig. 84). The small river Caridi was entirely concealed for many days; and when at length it reappeared, it had shaped for itself an entirely new channel.

Not far from Soriano, which was leveled by the massive earthquake in February, a small valley with a beautiful olive grove called Fra Ramondo experienced a remarkable change. Countless cracks created by the quake spread across the river plain in all directions, absorbing the water until the clay underneath got soaked, turning a large part of it into a thick paste. This caused strange changes in the landscape, as the soil could easily be shaped into different forms to a considerable depth. Additionally, debris from the nearby hills fell into the valley, uprooting many olive trees while others managed to grow on the fallen rubble, leaning at various angles (see fig. 84). The small river Caridi was completely hidden for many days, and when it finally reemerged, it had carved out a whole new path for itself.

Buildings transported entire to great distances.—Near Seminara an 486 extensive olive-ground and orchard were hurled to a distance of two hundred feet, into a valley sixty feet in depth. At the same time a deep chasm was riven in another part of the high platform from which the orchard had been detached, and the river immediately entered the fissure, leaving its former bed completely dry. A small inhabited house, standing on the mass of earth carried down into the valley, went along with it entire, and without injury to the inhabitants. The olive-trees, also, continued to grow on the land which had slid into the valley, and bore the same year an abundant crop of fruit.

Buildings were moved completely over great distances.—Near Seminara an 486 extensive olive grove and orchard were thrown two hundred feet into a valley that was sixty feet deep. At the same time, a deep chasm opened up in another part of the high ground from which the orchard had been separated, and the river quickly flowed into the crack, leaving its previous path totally dry. A small house, inhabited by people, was carried down into the valley along with the earth, and the residents remained unharmed. The olive trees also continued to thrive on the land that had slid into the valley, producing a plentiful crop of fruit that same year.

Fig. 84.Changes of the surface at Fra Ramondo, near Soriano, in Calabria.

Changes of the surface at Fra Ramondo, near Soriano, in Calabria.

Changes of the surface at Fra Ramondo, near Soriano, in Calabria.

1, Portion of a hill covered with olives thrown down.
2, New bed of the river Caridi.
3, Town of Soriano.

1, Part of a hill covered with olive trees has collapsed.
2, New riverbed of the Caridi.
3, Town of Soriano.

Two tracts of land on which a great part of the town of Polistena stood, consisting of some hundreds of houses, were detached into a contiguous ravine, and nearly across it, about half a mile from their original site; and what is most extraordinary, several of the inhabitants were dug out from the ruins alive and unhurt.

Two pieces of land where a large part of the town of Polistena was located, which included several hundred houses, fell into a nearby ravine, almost halfway across it, around half a mile from their original location; and what’s even more incredible is that several of the residents were rescued from the ruins alive and unharmed.

Two tenements, near Mileto, called the Macini and Vaticano, occupying an extent of ground about a mile long and half a mile broad, were carried for a mile down a valley. A thatched cottage, together with large olive and mulberry trees, most of which remained erect, were carried uninjured to this extraordinary distance. According to Hamilton, the surface removed had been long undermined by rivulets, which were afterwards in full view on the bare spot deserted by the tenements. The earthquake seems to have opened a passage in the adjoining argillaceous hills, which admitted water charged with loose soil into the subterranean channels of the rivulets immediately under the tenements, so that the foundations of the ground set in motion by the earthquake were loosened. Another example of subsidence, where the edifices 487 were not destroyed, is mentioned by Grimaldi, as having taken place in the city of Catanzaro, the capital of the province of that name. The houses in the quarter called San Giuseppe subsided with the ground to various depths from two to four feet, but the buildings remained uninjured.

Two buildings near Mileto, known as the Macini and Vaticano, covered about a mile in length and half a mile in width, were displaced a mile down a valley. A thatched cottage, along with large olive and mulberry trees—most of which stayed upright—were surprisingly carried intact over this extraordinary distance. According to Hamilton, the ground had been eroded for a long time by small streams, which were later visible on the bare area left behind by the buildings. The earthquake seems to have created a path in the nearby clay hills, allowing water mixed with loose soil to flow into the underground channels of the streams right beneath the buildings, causing the foundation of the ground affected by the earthquake to become unstable. Another instance of sinking ground, where the structures 487 weren't damaged, is noted by Grimaldi, occurring in the city of Catanzaro, the capital of that province. The houses in the area called San Giuseppe sank with the ground by varying depths of two to four feet, but the buildings remained unharmed.

Fig. 85.Landslips near Cinquefrondi, caused by the earthquake of 1783.

Landslips near Cinquefrondi, caused by the earthquake of 1783.

Landslides near Cinquefrondi, triggered by the earthquake in 1783.

It would be tedious, and our space would not permit us, to follow the different authors through their local details of landslips produced in minor valleys; but they are highly interesting, as showing to how great an extent the power of rivers to widen valleys, and to carry away large portions of soil towards the sea, is increased where earthquakes are of periodical occurrence. Among other territories, that of Cinquefrondi, was greatly convulsed, various portions of soil being raised or sunk, and innumerable fissures traversing the country in all directions (see fig. 85). Along the flanks of a small valley in this district there appears to have been an almost uninterrupted line of landslips.

It would be tedious, and our space wouldn't allow it, to follow the various authors through their local details of landslips happening in minor valleys; however, they are quite interesting, as they show how much the power of rivers to widen valleys and carry away large amounts of soil toward the sea is enhanced where earthquakes occur periodically. Among other areas, Cinquefrondi was significantly affected, with various sections of soil either raised or lowered, and countless cracks running through the country in every direction (see fig. 85). Along the sides of a small valley in this district, there seems to have been a nearly continuous line of landslips.

Currents of mud.—Near S. Lucido, among other places, the soil is described as having been "dissolved," so that large torrents of mud inundated all the low grounds, like lava. Just emerging from this mud, the tops only of trees and of the ruins of farm-houses were seen. Two miles from Laureana, the swampy soil in two ravines became filled with calcareous matter, which oozed out from the ground immediately before the first great shock. This mud, rapidly accumulating, began, ere long, to roll onward, like a flood of lava, into the valley, where the two streams uniting, moved forward with increased impetus from east to west. It now presented a breadth of 225 feet by 15 in depth, and, before it ceased to move, covered a surface equal in length to an Italian mile. In its progress it overwhelmed a flock of thirty goats, and tore up by the roots many olive and mulberry trees, which floated like ships upon its surface. When this calcareous lava had ceased to move, it gradually became dry and hard, during which process the mass was lowered seven feet and a 488 half. It contained fragments of earth of a ferruginous color, and emitting a sulphureous smell.

Currents of mud.—Near S. Lucido, among other places, the soil is described as having been "dissolved," causing massive mudflows to flood all the low-lying areas, similar to lava. Only the tops of trees and the remnants of farmhouses were visible, poking out from the mud. Two miles from Laureana, the swampy soil in two ravines filled with calcareous material that seeped from the ground right before the first major shock. This mud quickly piled up and soon started moving forward like a wave of lava into the valley, where the two streams merged, moving with even greater force from east to west. It now measured 225 feet wide and 15 feet deep, and before it finally stopped moving, it covered an area equivalent to an Italian mile in length. In its path, it swept away a herd of thirty goats and uprooted many olive and mulberry trees, which floated like ships on its surface. Once this calcareous lava stopped moving, it gradually dried out and hardened, during which time the mass sank seven and a half feet. It contained bits of reddish earth and gave off a sulfurous smell.

Fall of the sea-cliffs.—Along the sea-coast of the Straits of Messina, near the celebrated rock of Scilla, the fall of huge masses detached from the bold and lofty cliffs overwhelmed many villas and gardens. At Gian Greco, a continuous line of cliff, for a mile in length, was thrown down. Great agitation was frequently observed in the bed of the sea during the shocks, and, on those parts of the coast where the movement was most violent, all kinds of fish were taken in abundance, and with unusual facility. Some rare species, as that called Cicirelli, which usually lie buried in the sand, were taken on the surface of the waters in great quantity. The sea is said to have boiled up near Messina, and to have been agitated as if by a copious discharge of vapors from its bottom.

Fall of the sea-cliffs.—Along the coast of the Straits of Messina, near the famous rock of Scilla, huge chunks of the steep, tall cliffs broke off and buried many villas and gardens. At Gian Greco, a continuous stretch of cliff, a mile long, collapsed. A lot of movement was often seen in the sea during the tremors, and in the areas of the coast where the shaking was strongest, all kinds of fish were caught in large numbers and with surprising ease. Some rare species, like the Cicirelli, which usually hide in the sand, were found floating on the surface in great quantities. It’s said that the sea near Messina boiled up and was disturbed as if a massive release of vapors was coming from its depths.

Shore near Scilla inundated.—The prince of Scilla had persuaded a great part of his vassals to betake themselves to their fishing-boats for safety, and he himself had gone on board. On the night of the 5th of February, when some of the people were sleeping in the boats, and others on a level plain slightly elevated above the sea, the earth rocked, and suddenly a great mass was torn from the contiguous Mount Jaci, and thrown down with a dreadful crash upon the plain. Immediately afterwards, the sea, rising more than twenty feet above the level of this low tract, rolled foaming over it, and swept away the multitude. It then retreated, but soon rushed back again with greater violence, bringing with it some of the people and animals it had carried away. At the same time every boat was sunk or dashed against the beach, and some of them were swept far inland. The aged prince, with 1430 of his people, was destroyed.

Shore near Scilla flooded.—The prince of Scilla had convinced many of his vassals to get into their fishing boats for safety, and he had gone on board himself. On the night of February 5th, while some people were sleeping in the boats and others were on a slightly elevated plain above the sea, the ground shook, and suddenly a massive chunk fell from the nearby Mount Jaci with a terrible crash onto the plain. Immediately after, the sea surged more than twenty feet above this low area, crashing over it and sweeping away the crowd. It then receded but quickly surged back with even more force, bringing back some of the people and animals it had carried away. At the same time, every boat was either sunk or smashed against the shore, with some being carried far inland. The aging prince, along with 1,430 of his people, was lost.

State of Stromboli and Etna during the shocks.—The inhabitants of Pizzo remarked that on the 5th of February, 1783, when the first great shock afflicted Calabria, the volcano of Stromboli, which is in full view of that town, and at the distance of about fifty miles, smoked less, and threw up a less quantity of inflamed matter than it had done for some years previously. On the other hand, the great crater of Etna is said to have given out a considerable quantity of vapor towards the beginning, and Stromboli towards the close, of the commotions. But as no eruption happened from either of these great vents during the whole earthquake, the sources of the Calabrian convulsions, and of the volcanic fires of Etna and Stromboli, appear to be very independent of each other; unless, indeed, they have the same mutual relation as Vesuvius and the volcanoes of the Phlegræan Fields and Ischia, a violent disturbance in one district serving as a safety-valve to the other, and both never being in full activity at once.

State of Stromboli and Etna during the shocks.—The residents of Pizzo noted that on February 5, 1783, when the first major shock hit Calabria, the volcano of Stromboli, which is clearly visible from that town and about fifty miles away, emitted less smoke and released a smaller amount of glowing materials than it had in previous years. Conversely, the large crater of Etna reportedly released a significant amount of vapor at the beginning, while Stromboli did so towards the end of the disturbances. However, since neither volcano erupted during the entire earthquake, it seems that the sources of the Calabrian tremors and the volcanic activity of Etna and Stromboli are quite separate from each other; unless, of course, they share a similar relationship to Vesuvius and the volcanoes of the Phlegræan Fields and Ischia, where a major disturbance in one area acts as a safety valve for the other, preventing both from being fully active at the same time.

Excavation of valleys.—It is impossible for the geologist to consider attentively the effect of this single earthquake of 1783, and to look forward to the alterations in the physical condition of the country to which a continued series of such movements will hereafter give rise, without perceiving that the formation of valleys by running water can never be 489 understood, if we consider the question independently of the agency of earthquakes. It must not be imagined that rivers only begin to act when a country is already elevated far above the level of the sea, for their action must of necessity be most powerful while land is rising and sinking by successive movements. Whether Calabria is now undergoing any considerable change of relative level, in regard to the sea, or is, upon the whole, nearly stationary, is a question which our observations, confined almost entirely to the last half century, cannot possibly enable us to determine. But we know that strata, containing species of shells identical with those now living in the contiguous parts of the Mediterranean, have been raised in that country, as they have in Sicily, to the height of several thousand feet.

Excavation of valleys.—The geologist can't closely examine the impact of the 1783 earthquake and anticipate the changes in the country's physical landscape that will come from a series of similar events without understanding that the formation of valleys by flowing water cannot be fully grasped if we ignore the role of earthquakes. It's a misconception that rivers only start to shape the land when it is already significantly above sea level; their influence is actually most intense while the land is rising and sinking through repeated movements. Whether Calabria is currently experiencing any major changes in its height relative to the sea, or if it is mostly stable, is a question our observations, which have mostly covered the last fifty years, can't answer. However, we do know that layers of rock containing shell species identical to those still found in nearby areas of the Mediterranean have been raised in that region, as has occurred in Sicily, to several thousand feet.

Now, those geologists who grant that the present course of Nature in the inanimate world has continued the same since the existing species of animals were in being, will not feel surprised that the Calabrian streams and rivers have cut out of such comparatively modern strata a great system of valleys, varying in depth from fifty to six hundred feet, and often several miles wide, if they consider how numerous may have been the shocks which accompanied the uplifting of those recent marine strata to so prodigious a height. Some speculators, indeed, who disregard the analogy of existing nature, and who are always ready to assume that her forces were more energetic in by-gone ages, may dispense with a long series of movements, and suppose that Calabria "rose like an exhalation" from the deep, after the manner of Milton's Pandemonium. But such an hypothesis would deprive them of that peculiar removing force required to form a regular system of deep and wide valleys; for time, which they are so unwilling to assume, is essential to the operation. Time must be allowed in the intervals between distinct convulsions, for running water to clear away the ruins caused by landslips, otherwise the fallen masses will serve as buttresses, and prevent the succeeding earthquake from exerting its full power. The sides of the valley must be again cut away by the stream, and made to form precipices and overhanging cliffs, before the next shock can take effect in the same manner.

Now, geologists who believe that the current processes of nature in the inanimate world have remained unchanged since the current animal species came into existence won’t be surprised that the Calabrian streams and rivers have carved out a vast system of valleys from relatively modern layers of rock, ranging in depth from fifty to six hundred feet and often several miles wide, especially when they consider how many shocks occurred during the uplifting of those recent marine layers to such an astonishing height. Some theorists, however, who ignore the analogy of nature today and are quick to assume that its forces were much stronger in the past, might skip over a long series of movements and imagine that Calabria "rose like an exhalation" from the depths, similar to Milton's Pandemonium. But this idea would take away the essential, gradual forces needed to create a regular system of deep and wide valleys; because time, which they are reluctant to acknowledge, is crucial for this process. Time must pass between significant disruptions, allowing running water to wash away the debris from landslips, or else the fallen material will act as support and prevent the next earthquake from fully exerting its impact. The valley sides must be reshaped by the stream again, creating cliffs and overhangs, before the next quake can have a similar effect.

Possibly the direction of the succeeding shock may not coincide with that of the valley, a great extent of adjacent country being equally shaken. Still it will usually happen that no permanent geographical change will be produced except in valleys. In them alone will occur landslips from the boundary cliffs, and these will frequently divert the stream from its accustomed course, causing the original ravine to become both wider and more tortuous in its direction.

Possibly the direction of the next shock may not match that of the valley, as a large area of surrounding land can be equally affected. However, it usually turns out that no lasting geographical changes occur except in valleys. Only in those will landslips happen from the surrounding cliffs, and these will often redirect the stream from its usual path, making the original ravine wider and more winding.

If a single convulsion of extreme violence should agitate at once an entire hydrographical basin, or if the shocks should follow each other too rapidly, the previously existing valleys would be annihilated, instead of being modified and enlarged. Every stream might in that case be compelled to begin its operations anew, and to shape out new channels, instead of continuing to deepen and widen those already excavated. But if the subterranean movements have been intermittent, and if sufficient 490 periods have always intervened between the severer shocks to allow the drainage of the country to be nearly restored to its original state, then are both the kind and degree of force supplied by which running water may hollow out valleys of any depth or size consistent with the elevation above the sea which the districts drained by them may have attained.

If a sudden surge of extreme violence were to shake an entire watershed at once, or if the shocks happened too quickly one after another, the valleys that existed before would be destroyed instead of just altered or expanded. In that case, every river might have to start fresh, creating new channels instead of continuing to deepen and widen the ones already there. However, if the underground movements happen intermittently, and if enough time passes between stronger shocks to let the drainage system of the area nearly return to its original state, then both the type and level of force provided can enable running water to carve out valleys of any depth or size appropriate for the elevation of the regions they drain.

When we read of the drying up and desertion of the channels of rivers, the accounts most frequently refer to their deflection into some other part of the same alluvial plain, perhaps several miles distant. Under certain circumstances a change of level may undoubtedly force the water to flow over into some distinct hydrographical basin; but even then it will fall immediately into some other system of valleys already formed.

When we read about rivers drying up and being abandoned, the reports usually talk about how they redirect to another area of the same floodplain, possibly several miles away. In some cases, a change in elevation can definitely cause the water to flow into a different watershed; but even then, it will quickly join another set of existing valleys.

We learn from history that, ever since the first Greek colonists settled in Calabria, that region has been subject to devastation by earthquakes; and, for the last century and a half, ten years have seldom elapsed without a shock; but the severer convulsions have not only been separated by intervals of twenty, fifty, or one hundred years, but have not affected precisely the same points when they recurred. Thus the earthquake of 1783, although confined within the same geographical limits as that of 1638, and not very inferior in violence, visited, according to Grimaldi, very different districts. The points where the local intensity of the force is developed being thus perpetually varied, more time is allowed for the removal of separate mountain masses thrown into river-channels by each shock.

We learn from history that since the first Greek colonists settled in Calabria, that region has been repeatedly devastated by earthquakes. Over the last century and a half, ten years rarely go by without a tremor; however, the more severe quakes have not only been spaced out by twenty, fifty, or even one hundred years, but they have also hit different areas each time. For example, the earthquake of 1783, although it occurred within the same geographic boundaries as the one in 1638 and was similarly intense, impacted very different districts, according to Grimaldi. Since the locations where the strongest force is felt keep changing, more time is given for the repositioning of separate mountain masses that are displaced into river channels by each shake.

Number of persons who perished during the earthquake.—The number of persons who perished during the earthquake in the two Calabrias and Sicily, is estimated by Hamilton at about forty thousand; and about twenty thousand more died by epidemics, which were caused by insufficient nourishment, exposure to the atmosphere, and malaria, arising from the new stagnant lakes and pools.

Number of persons who died during the earthquake.—The number of people who died during the earthquake in the two Calabrias and Sicily is estimated by Hamilton to be around forty thousand; and about twenty thousand more died from epidemics caused by inadequate food, exposure to the weather, and malaria from the new stagnant lakes and pools.

By far the greater number were buried under the ruins of their houses; but many were burnt to death in the conflagrations which almost invariably followed the shocks. These fires raged the more violently in some cities, such as Oppido, from the immense magazines of oil which were consumed.

By far the majority were buried under the rubble of their homes; but many died in the fires that almost always followed the shocks. These fires spread even more fiercely in some cities, like Oppido, due to the large stockpiles of oil that were ignited.

Many persons were engulfed in deep fissures, especially the peasants when flying across the open country, and their skeletons may perhaps be buried in the earth to this day, at the depth of several hundred feet.

Many people were caught in deep cracks, especially the farmers, when moving across the open land, and their remains might still be buried in the ground today, at a depth of several hundred feet.

When Dolomieu visited Messina after the shock of Feb. 5th, he describes the city as still presenting, at least at a distance, an imperfect image of its ancient splendor. Every house was injured, but the walls were standing; the whole population had taken refuge in wooden huts in the neighborhood, and all was solitude and silence in the streets: it seemed as if the city had been desolated by the plague, and the impression made upon his feelings was that of melancholy and sadness. "But when I passed over to Calabria, and first beheld Polistena, the scene of horror almost deprived me of my faculties; my mind was filled with mingled compassion and terror; nothing had escaped; all was levelled 491 with the dust; not a single house or piece of wall remained; on all sides were heaps of stone so destitute of form, that they gave no conception of there ever having been a town on the spot. The stench of the dead bodies still rose from the ruins. I conversed with many persons who had been buried for three, four, and even for five days; I questioned them respecting their sensations in so dreadful a situation, and they agreed that of all the physical evils they endured, thirst was the most intolerable; and that their mental agony was increased by the idea that they were abandoned by their friends, who might have rendered them assistance."672

When Dolomieu visited Messina after the earthquake on February 5th, he described the city as still showing, at least from a distance, an imperfect image of its former glory. Every house was damaged, but the walls were still standing; the entire population had taken refuge in wooden huts nearby, and the streets were filled with solitude and silence: it felt as though the city had been devastated by a plague, leaving him with a sense of melancholy and sadness. "But when I went over to Calabria and first saw Polistena, the scene of horror nearly overwhelmed me; my mind was filled with a mix of compassion and terror; nothing was spared; everything was reduced to dust; not a single house or remnant of a wall remained; all around were piles of stone so shapeless that they gave no indication that a town had ever been there. The stench of the dead bodies still lingered in the ruins. I spoke with many people who had been trapped for three, four, and even five days; I asked them about their feelings in such a dreadful situation, and they all agreed that of all the physical sufferings they experienced, thirst was the most unbearable; and that their mental anguish was worsened by the thought that they were abandoned by their friends, who could have helped them." 491

It is supposed that about a fourth part of the inhabitants of Polistena, and of some other towns, were buried alive, and might have been saved had there been no want of hands; but in so general a calamity, where each was occupied with his own misfortunes or those of his family, aid could rarely be obtained. Neither tears, nor supplications, nor promises of high rewards were listened to. Many acts of self-devotion, prompted by parental and conjugal tenderness, or by friendship, or the gratitude of faithful servants, are recorded; but individual exertions were, for the most part, ineffectual. It frequently happened, that persons in search of those most dear to them could hear their moans,—could recognize their voices—were certain of the exact spot where they lay buried beneath their feet, yet could afford them no succor. The piled mass resisted all their strength, and rendered their efforts of no avail.

It’s estimated that about a quarter of the people in Polistena and some other towns were buried alive and could have been saved if there had been enough people to help. But in such a widespread disaster, when everyone was focused on their own troubles or those of their families, it was hard to get assistance. Neither tears, nor pleas, nor offers of huge rewards were heeded. Many acts of selflessness driven by parental and marital love, friendship, or the gratitude of loyal servants are noted; however, individual efforts were mostly ineffective. It often happened that people searching for their loved ones could hear their cries—could recognize their voices—were sure of the exact spot where they lay buried beneath them, yet they couldn’t help them. The weight of the rubble resisted all their strength, making their efforts futile.

At Terranuova, four Augustin monks, who had taken refuge in a vaulted sacristy, the arch of which continued to support an immense pile of ruins, made their cries heard for the space of four days. One only of the brethren of the whole convent was saved, and "of what avail was his strength to remove the enormous weight of rubbish which had overwhelmed his companions?" He heard their voices die away gradually; and when afterwards their four corpses were disinterred, they were found clasped in each other's arms. Affecting narratives are preserved of mothers saved after the fifth, sixth, and even seventh day of their interment, when their infants or children had perished with hunger.

At Terranuova, four Augustinian monks took shelter in a vaulted sacristy, which still held up a massive pile of ruins. They cried out for help for four days. Only one of the monks from the whole convent was saved, and “how could he possibly lift the huge weight of debris that had buried his companions?” He listened as their voices slowly faded away; later, when their four bodies were recovered, they were found embraced in each other’s arms. Touching stories have been recorded of mothers saved after the fifth, sixth, and even seventh day of being trapped, while their infants or children had starved to death.

It might have been imagined that the sight of sufferings such as these would have been sufficient to awaken sentiments of humanity and pity in the most savage breasts; but while some acts of heroism are related, nothing could exceed the general atrocity of conduct displayed by the Calabrian peasants: they abandoned the farms, and flocked in great numbers into the towns—not to rescue their countrymen from a lingering death, but to plunder. They dashed through the streets, fearless of danger, amid tottering walls and clouds of dust, trampling beneath their feet the bodies of the wounded and half-buried, and often stripping them, while yet living, of their clothes.673

It might be expected that witnessing suffering like this would spark feelings of compassion and empathy in even the most cruel individuals; however, while some acts of bravery are reported, nothing can compare to the overall brutality shown by the Calabrian peasants. They left their farms and rushed into the towns—not to save their fellow countrymen from a slow death, but to loot. They charged through the streets, unafraid of danger, among crumbling walls and clouds of dust, trampling on the bodies of the injured and partially buried, and often robbing them of their clothes while they were still alive.673

Concluding remarks.—But to enter more fully into these details would be foreign to the purpose of the present work, and several volumes 492 would be required to give the reader a just idea of the sufferings which the inhabitants of many populous districts have undergone during the earthquakes of the last 150 years. A bare mention of the loss of life—as that fifty or a hundred thousand souls perished in one catastrophe—conveys to the reader no idea of the extent of misery inflicted: we must learn, from the narratives of eye-witnesses, the various forms in which death was encountered, the numbers who escaped with loss of limbs or serious bodily injuries, and the multitude who were suddenly reduced to penury and want. It has been often remarked, that the dread of earthquakes is strongest in the minds of those who have experienced them most frequently; whereas, in the case of almost every other danger, familiarity with peril renders men intrepid. The reason is obvious—scarcely any part of the mischief apprehended in this instance is imaginary; the first shock is often the most destructive; and, as it may occur in the dead of the night, or if by day, without giving the least warning of its approach, no forethought can guard against it; and when the convulsion has begun, no skill, or courage, or presence of mind, can point out the path of safety. During the intervals, of uncertain duration, between the more fatal shocks, slight tremors of the soil are not unfrequent; and as these sometimes precede more violent convulsions, they become a source of anxiety and alarm. The terror arising from this cause alone is of itself no inconsiderable evil.

Concluding remarks.—But going into these details would stray from the purpose of this work, and several volumes 492 would be needed to give the reader a true sense of the suffering that many populated areas have endured during the earthquakes of the last 150 years. Just mentioning the loss of life—like fifty or a hundred thousand people dying in one disaster—doesn't fully convey the extent of the misery caused. We need to hear from eyewitness accounts about the different ways people faced death, how many survived with lost limbs or serious injuries, and the many who were suddenly left in poverty and need. It’s often noted that the fear of earthquakes is strongest among those who have experienced them most frequently; meanwhile, with nearly every other danger, familiarity with risk makes people brave. The reason is clear—almost none of the fear in this case is imaginary; the initial shock is often the most destructive; and because it can happen in the dead of night or, during the day, without any warning, no amount of forethought can prepare for it. Once the shaking begins, no skill, bravery, or quick thinking can guarantee a safe escape. In the unpredictable intervals between the more deadly shocks, minor tremors happen frequently; and since these sometimes come before stronger quakes, they add to the anxiety and fear. The terror from this alone is a significant problem.

Although sentiments of pure religion are frequently awakened by these awful visitations, yet we more commonly find that an habitual state of fear, a sense of helplessness, and a belief in the futility of all human exertions, prepare the minds of the vulgar for the influence of a demoralizing superstition.

Although feelings of true spirituality are often stirred by these terrible events, we usually see that a constant state of fear, a feeling of powerlessness, and a belief in the uselessness of all human efforts, set the stage for the general public to fall under the sway of a corrupting superstition.

Where earthquakes are frequent, there can never be perfect security of property under the best government; industry cannot be assured of reaping the fruits of its labor; and the most daring acts of outrage may occasionally be perpetrated with impunity, when the arm of the law is paralyzed by the general consternation. It is hardly necessary to add, that the progress of civilization and national wealth must be retarded by convulsions which level cities to the ground, destroy harbors, render roads impassable, and cause the most cultivated valley-plains to be covered with lakes, or the ruins of adjoining hills.

Where earthquakes happen often, there can never be complete safety for property, even under the best government; businesses can’t rely on enjoying the benefits of their hard work; and the boldest acts of violence might sometimes happen without punishment, especially when the law is rendered ineffective by widespread panic. It’s unnecessary to mention that the advancement of civilization and national wealth will be slowed down by disasters that flatten cities, destroy ports, make roads unusable, and turn the most fertile valleys into lakes or piles of debris from nearby hills.

Those geologists who imagine that, at remote periods ere man became a sojourner on earth, the volcanic agency was more energetic than now, should be careful to found their opinion on strict geological evidence, and not permit themselves to be biased, as they have often been, by a notion, that the disturbing force would probably be mitigated for the sake of man.

Those geologists who believe that, in distant times before humans existed on Earth, volcanic activity was more intense than it is today, should make sure to base their views on solid geological evidence and not let themselves be swayed, as they often are, by the idea that the forces of nature would likely be lessened for the benefit of humanity.

I shall endeavor to point out in the sequel, that the general tendency of subterranean movements, when their effects are considered for a sufficient lapse of ages, is eminently beneficial, and that they constitute an essential part of that mechanism by which the integrity of the habitable surface is preserved, and the very existence and perpetuation of dry land 493 secured. Why the working of this same machinery should be attended with so much evil, is a mystery far beyond the reach of our philosophy, and must probably remain so until we are permitted to investigate, not our planet alone and its inhabitants, but other parts of the moral and material universe with which they may be connected. Could our survey embrace other worlds, and the events, not of a few centuries only, but of periods as indefinite as those with which geology renders us familiar, some apparent contradictions might be reconciled, and some difficulties would doubtless be cleared up. But even then, as our capacities are finite, while the scheme of the universe may be infinite, both in time and space, it is presumptuous to suppose that all sources of doubt and perplexity would ever be removed. On the contrary, they might, perhaps, go on augmenting in number, although our confidence in the wisdom of the plan of Nature should increase at the same time; for it has been justly said, that the greater the circle of light, the greater the boundary of darkness by which it is surrounded.674

I will try to show in the following sections that the overall trend of underground movements, when we look at their effects over a long enough period, is clearly beneficial, and that they are a crucial part of the system that maintains the stability of the land we live on and ensures the existence and continuity of dry land. Why this same system should also bring about so much harm is a mystery that is well beyond our understanding and likely will remain so until we are able to study not just our planet and its inhabitants but also other areas of the moral and material universe that may be connected to them. If we could explore other worlds and events that span not just a few centuries but periods as long as those that geology shows us, we might be able to resolve some apparent contradictions and clear up some issues. However, even then, since our understanding is limited while the universe's design may be infinite in both time and space, it's arrogant to think that all sources of confusion and uncertainty could ever be fully explained. On the contrary, they might even multiply, even as our faith in the wisdom behind Nature's plan grows; for it's been rightly pointed out that the larger the circle of light, the greater the expanse of darkness that surrounds it.493


CHAPTER XXIX.

EARTHQUAKES—continued.

Earthquake of Java, 1772—Truncation of a lofty cone—St. Domingo, 1770—Lisbon, 1755—Great area over which the shocks extended—Retreat of the sea—Proposed explanations—Conception Bay, 1750—Permanent elevation—Peru, 1746—Java, 1699—Rivers obstructed by landslips—Subsidence in Sicily, 1693—Moluccas, 1693—Jamaica, 1692—Large tracts engulfed—Portion of Port Royal sunk—Amount of change in the last 150 years—Elevation and subsidence of land in Bay of Baiæ—Evidence of the same afforded by the Temple of Serapis.

Earthquake of Java, 1772—Collapse of a tall cone—St. Domingo, 1770—Lisbon, 1755—Wide area affected by the shocks—Receding sea—Suggested explanations—Conception Bay, 1750—Permanent land uplift—Peru, 1746—Java, 1699—Rivers blocked by landslides—Land sinking in Sicily, 1693—Moluccas, 1693—Jamaica, 1692—Large areas submerged—Part of Port Royal sank—Extent of change in the last 150 years—Rising and sinking land in the Bay of Baiæ—Proof of this shown by the Temple of Serapis.

In the preceding chapters we have considered a small part only of those earthquakes which have occurred during the last seventy years, of which accurate and authentic descriptions happen to have been recorded. In examining those of earlier date, we find their number so great that allusion can be made to a few only respecting which information of peculiar geological interest has been obtained.

In the previous chapters, we have looked at just a small portion of the earthquakes that have happened over the last seventy years, for which we have accurate and reliable descriptions. When looking at those from earlier times, we find that their number is so high that we can only reference a few for which we have particularly interesting geological information.

Java, 1772.—Truncation of a lofty cone.—In the year 1772, Papandayang, formerly one of the loftiest volcanoes in the island of Java, was in eruption. Before all the inhabitants on the declivities of the mountain could save themselves by flight, the ground began to give way, and a great part of the volcano fell in and disappeared. It is estimated that an extent of ground of the mountain itself and its immediate environs, 494 fifteen miles long and full six broad, was by this commotion swallowed up in the bowels of the earth. Forty villages were destroyed, some being engulfed and some covered by the substances thrown out on this occasion, and 2957 of the inhabitants perished. A proportionate number of cattle were also killed, and most of the plantations of cotton, indigo, and coffee in the adjacent districts were buried under the volcanic matter. This catastrophe appears to have resembled, although on a grander scale, that of the ancient Vesuvius in the year 79. The cone was reduced in height from 9000 to about 5000 feet; and, as vapors still escape from the crater on its summit, a new cone may one day rise out of the ruins of the ancient mountain, as the modern Vesuvius has risen from the remains of Somma.675

Java, 1772.—Truncation of a lofty cone.—In 1772, Papandayang, which used to be one of the tallest volcanoes on the island of Java, erupted. Before all the people living on the slopes of the mountain could escape, the ground started to collapse, and a large part of the volcano fell in and vanished. It is estimated that about fifteen miles of the mountain itself and its surrounding area, measuring roughly six miles wide, were swallowed up by this upheaval. Forty villages were destroyed, with some being completely buried and others covered by the debris ejected during the eruption, resulting in the deaths of 2,957 inhabitants. A significant number of cattle also perished, and most of the cotton, indigo, and coffee plantations in the nearby areas were buried under volcanic ash. This disaster seems to have been similar, though on a larger scale, to that of the ancient eruption of Vesuvius in 79 AD. The height of the cone was reduced from 9,000 to about 5,000 feet; and, as vapors continue to escape from the crater at its summit, a new cone might eventually rise from the remnants of the old mountain, just as modern Vesuvius emerged from the ruins of Somma.675

St. Domingo, 1770.—During a tremendous earthquake which destroyed a great part of St. Domingo, innumerable fissures were caused throughout the island, from which mephitic vapors emanated and produced an epidemic. Hot springs burst forth in many places where there had been no water before; but after a time they ceased to flow.676

St. Domingo, 1770.—During a massive earthquake that devastated much of St. Domingo, countless cracks appeared all over the island, releasing toxic gases that led to an epidemic. Hot springs emerged in several locations where there had previously been no water; however, they eventually stopped flowing.676

In a previous earthquake, in November, 1751, a violent shock destroyed the capital, Port au Prince, and part of the coast, twenty leagues in length, sank down, and has ever since formed a bay of the sea.677

In a previous earthquake in November 1751, a strong tremor devastated the capital, Port-au-Prince, and caused part of the coast, stretching twenty leagues, to sink, which has since created a bay of the sea.677

Hindostan, 1762.—The town of Chittagong, in Bengal, was violently shaken by an earthquake, on the 2d of April, 1762, the earth opening in many places, and throwing up water and mud of a sulphureous smell. At a place called Bardavan, a large river was dried up; and at Bar Charra, near the sea, a tract of ground sunk down, and 200 people, with all their cattle, were lost. It is said, that sixty square miles of the Chittagong coast suddenly and permanently subsided during this earthquake, and that Ces-lung-Toom, one of the Mug mountains, entirely disappeared, and another sank so low, that its summit only remained visible. Four hills are also described as having been variously rent asunder, leaving open chasms from thirty to sixty feet in width. Towns which subsided several cubits, were overflowed with water; among others, Deep Gong, which was submerged to the depth of seven cubits. Two volcanoes are said to have opened in the Secta Cunda hills. The shock was also felt at Calcutta.678 While the Chittagong coast was sinking, a corresponding rise of the ground took place at the island of Ramree, and at Cheduba (see Map, fig. 39, p. 351).679

Hindostan, 1762.—On April 2, 1762, the town of Chittagong in Bengal was violently shaken by an earthquake, causing the ground to crack open in many places and spewing up water and mud with a sulfurous odor. At a location called Bardavan, a large river ran dry; and at Bar Charra, near the sea, a section of land collapsed, resulting in the loss of 200 people and all their livestock. It is reported that sixty square miles of the Chittagong coast suddenly and permanently sank during this earthquake, and that Ces-lung-Toom, one of the Mug mountains, completely vanished, while another sank so low that only its peak was visible. Four hills were described as having been torn apart, leaving open cracks ranging from thirty to sixty feet wide. Towns that sank several cubits were flooded, including Deep Gong, which was submerged to a depth of seven cubits. Two volcanoes are said to have erupted in the Secta Cunda hills. The tremors were also felt in Calcutta.678 As the Chittagong coast sank, the ground at Ramree Island and Cheduba rose accordingly (see Map, fig. 39, p. 351).679

Lisbon, 1755.—In no part of the volcanic region of southern Europe 495 has so tremendous an earthquake occurred in modern times, as that which began on the 1st of November, 1755, at Lisbon. A sound of thunder was heard underground, and immediately afterwards a violent shock threw down the greater part of that city. In the course of about six minutes, sixty thousand persons perished. The sea first retired and laid the bar dry; it then rolled in, rising fifty feet or more above its ordinary level. The mountains of Arrabida, Estrella, Julio, Marvan, and Cintra, being some of the largest in Portugal, were impetuously shaken, as it were, from their very foundations; and some of them opened at their summits, which were split and rent in a wonderful manner, huge masses of them being thrown down into the subjacent valleys.680 Flames are related to have issued from these mountains, which are supposed to have been electric; they are also said to have smoked; but vast clouds of dust may have given rise to this appearance.

Lisbon, 1755.—In no other part of the volcanic region of southern Europe has there been such a massive earthquake in modern times as the one that struck on November 1, 1755, in Lisbon. A rumbling like thunder was heard underground, and shortly after, a powerful shock caused most of the city to collapse. In about six minutes, sixty thousand people lost their lives. The sea first receded and exposed the sandbar; then it surged back in, rising more than fifty feet above its usual level. The mountains of Arrabida, Estrella, Julio, Marvan, and Cintra, among the tallest in Portugal, were violently shaken as if they were being uprooted; some even opened at their peaks, which were split apart in a remarkable way, with large chunks tumbling down into the valleys below.680 Flames were reported to have erupted from these mountains, believed to be of an electric nature; they were also said to have emitted smoke, though large clouds of dust might have contributed to this effect.

The area over which this convulsion extended is very remarkable. It has been computed, says Humboldt,681 that on the 1st November, 1755, a portion of the earth's surface four times greater than the extent of Europe was simultaneously shaken. The shock was felt in the Alps, and on the coast of Sweden, in small inland lakes on the shores of the Baltic, in Thuringia, and in the flat country of northern Germany. The thermal springs of Toplitz dried up, and again returned, inundating every thing with water discolored by ochre. In the islands of Antigua, Barbadoes, and Martinique in the West Indies, where the tide usually rises little more than two feet, it suddenly rose above twenty feet, the water being discolored and of an inky blackness. The movement was also sensible in the great lakes of Canada. At Algiers and Fez, in the north of Africa, the agitation of the earth was as violent as in Spain and Portugal; and at the distance of eight leagues from Morocco, a village with the inhabitants, to the number of about 8000 or 10,000 persons, are said to have been swallowed up; the earth soon afterwards closing over them.

The area affected by this upheaval is quite remarkable. It has been estimated, according to Humboldt,681 that on November 1, 1755, a section of the Earth's surface four times larger than Europe was shaken at the same time. The tremors were felt in the Alps and on the coast of Sweden, in small inland lakes along the Baltic, in Thuringia, and in the flatlands of northern Germany. The thermal springs of Toplitz dried up and then returned, flooding everything with water colored by ochre. In the islands of Antigua, Barbados, and Martinique in the West Indies, where the tide usually rises only about two feet, it suddenly climbed above twenty feet, with the water dark and inky. The movement was also felt in the large lakes of Canada. In Algiers and Fez, in northern Africa, the shaking of the ground was as intense as in Spain and Portugal; and about eight leagues from Morocco, a village with around 8,000 to 10,000 inhabitants was reportedly swallowed up, with the earth soon closing over them.

Subsidence of the quay.—Among other extraordinary events related to have occurred at Lisbon during the catastrophe was the subsidence of a new quay, built entirely of marble at an immense expense. A great concourse of people had collected there for safety, as a spot where they might be beyond the reach of falling ruins; but suddenly the quay sank down with all the people on it, and not one of the dead bodies ever floated to the surface. A great number of boats and small vessels anchored near it, all full of people, were swallowed up, as in a whirlpool.682 No fragments of these wrecks ever rose again to the surface, and the water in the place where the quay had stood is stated, in many accounts, to be unfathomable; but Whitehurst says he ascertained it to be one hundred fathoms.683

Subsidence of the quay.—Among other extraordinary events that took place in Lisbon during the disaster was the sinking of a new quay, built entirely of marble at a huge cost. A large crowd had gathered there for safety, believing it to be a place where they would be safe from falling debris; but suddenly, the quay collapsed with everyone on it, and none of the bodies ever floated to the surface. Many boats and small vessels anchored nearby, all packed with people, were pulled down as if by a whirlpool.682 No pieces of these wrecks ever resurfaced, and the water where the quay once was is reported in many accounts to be bottomless; however, Whitehurst claims he measured it at one hundred fathoms.683

496 Circumstantial as are the contemporary narratives, I learn from a correspondent, Mr. F. Freeman, in 1841, that no part of the Tagus was then more than thirty feet deep at high tide, and an examination of the position of the new quay, and the memorials preserved of the time and manner in which it was built, rendered the statement of so great a subsidence in 1755 quite unintelligible. Perhaps a deep narrow chasm, such as was before described in Calabria (p. 481), opened and closed again in the bed of the Tagus, after swallowing up some incumbent buildings and vessels. We have already seen that such openings may collapse after the shock suddenly, or, in places where the strata are of soft and yielding materials, very gradually. According to the observations made at Lisbon, in 1837, by Mr. Sharpe, the destroying effects of this earthquake were confined to the tertiary strata, and were most violent on the blue clay, on which the lower part of the city is constructed. Not a building, he says, on the secondary limestone or the basalt was injured.684

496 Despite the circumstantial nature of contemporary accounts, I learned from a correspondent, Mr. F. Freeman, in 1841, that no part of the Tagus was more than thirty feet deep at high tide. An examination of the position of the new quay and the records kept from the time it was built made the claim of such a significant subsidence in 1755 completely unclear. It's possible that a deep narrow chasm, similar to the one previously described in Calabria (p. 481), opened and closed in the bed of the Tagus, swallowing some nearby buildings and vessels. We have already noted that such openings may collapse suddenly after the shock, or gradually in areas where the ground is made up of soft and flexible materials. According to observations made in Lisbon in 1837 by Mr. Sharpe, the destructive effects of this earthquake were limited to the tertiary layers, particularly affecting the blue clay on which the lower part of the city is built. He noted that not a single building on the secondary limestone or basalt was damaged.684

Shocks felt at sea.—The shock was felt at sea, on the deck of a ship to the west of Lisbon, and produced very much the same sensation as on dry land. Off St. Lucar, the captain of the ship Nancy felt his vessel so violently shaken, that he thought she had struck the ground; but, on heaving the lead, found a great depth of water. Captain Clark, from Denia, in latitude 36° 24' N., between nine and ten in the morning, had his ship shaken and strained as if she had struck upon a rock, so that the seams of the deck opened, and the compass was overturned in the binnacle. Another ship, forty leagues west of St. Vincent, experienced so violent a concussion, that the men were thrown a foot and a half perpendicularly up from the deck.

Shocks felt at sea.—The shock was felt at sea, on the deck of a ship west of Lisbon, and it produced a sensation very similar to that on dry land. Off St. Lucar, the captain of the ship Nancy felt his vessel shaken so violently that he thought it had hit the ground; however, after checking the depth, he found there was a great amount of water below. Captain Clark, from Denia, at latitude 36° 24' N., experienced his ship shaking and straining as if it had hit a rock between nine and ten in the morning, causing the seams of the deck to open and the compass to be overturned in the binnacle. Another ship, forty leagues west of St. Vincent, underwent such a violent shock that the crew was thrown a foot and a half straight up from the deck.

Rate at which the movement travelled.—The agitation of lakes, rivers, and springs, in Great Britain, was remarkable. At Loch Lomond, in Scotland, for example, the water, without, the least apparent cause, rose against its banks, and then subsided below its usual level. The greatest perpendicular height of this swell was two feet four inches. It is said that the movement of this earthquake was undulatory, and that it travelled at the rate of twenty miles a minute, its velocity being calculated by the intervals between the time when the first shock was felt at Lisbon, and its time of occurrence at other distant places.685

Rate at which the movement traveled.—The agitation of lakes, rivers, and springs in Great Britain was remarkable. For instance, at Loch Lomond in Scotland, the water, with no obvious cause, rose against its banks and then fell below its usual level. The highest point of this swell was two feet four inches. It's reported that the movement of this earthquake was wave-like and traveled at a speed of twenty miles a minute, with its velocity determined by the time gaps between when the first shock was felt in Lisbon and when it occurred in other distant locations.685

Great wave and retreat of the sea.—A great wave swept over the coast of Spain, and is said to have been sixty feet high at Cadiz. At Tangier, in Africa, it rose and fell eighteen times on the coast. At Funchal, in Madeira, it rose full fifteen feet perpendicular above high-water mark, although the tide, which ebbs and flows there seven feet, was then at half-ebb. Besides entering the city, and committing great havoc, it overflowed other seaports in the island. At Kinsale, in Ireland, a body of water rushed into the harbor, whirled round several vessels, and poured into the market-place.

Great wave and retreat of the sea.—A massive wave hit the coast of Spain, reportedly reaching sixty feet high at Cadiz. At Tangier, in Africa, it surged and receded eighteen times along the coast. At Funchal, in Madeira, it rose a full fifteen feet straight above the high-water mark, even though the tide, which typically ebbs and flows seven feet there, was at half-ebb at the time. In addition to flooding the city and causing widespread damage, it also overflowed other ports on the island. In Kinsale, Ireland, a large surge of water rushed into the harbor, spun several boats around, and flooded the marketplace.

497 It was before stated that the sea first retired at Lisbon; and this retreat of the ocean from the shore, at the commencement of an earthquake, and its subsequent return in a violent wave, is a common occurrence. In order to account for the phenomenon, Michell imagined a subsidence at the bottom of the sea, from the giving way of the roof of some cavity in consequence of a vacuum produced by the condensation of steam. Such condensation, he observes, might be the first effect of the introduction of a large body of water into fissures and cavities already filled with steam, before there has been sufficient time for the heat of the incandescent lava to turn so large a supply of water into steam, which being soon accomplished causes a greater explosion.

497 It was previously mentioned that the sea first receded at Lisbon; this retreat of the ocean from the shore at the start of an earthquake, followed by its swift return in a powerful wave, is a common event. To explain this phenomenon, Michell proposed that there was a sinking at the ocean floor due to the collapse of the roof of some cavity, caused by the vacuum created by steam condensation. He suggests that this condensation could be the initial effect of a large amount of water entering fissures and cavities already filled with steam, before there was enough time for the heat from the molten lava to transform that large supply of water into steam, which happens quickly and leads to a larger explosion.

Another proposed explanation is, the sudden rise of the land, which would cause the sea to abandon immediately the ancient line of coast; and if the shore, after being thus heaved up, should fall again to its original level, the ocean would return. This theory, however, will not account for the facts observed during the Lisbon earthquake; for the retreat preceded the wave, not only on the coast of Portugal, but also at the island of Madeira, and several other places. If the upheaving of the coast of Portugal had caused the retreat, the motion of the waters, when propagated to Madeira, would have produced a wave previous to the retreat. Nor could the motion of the waters at Madeira have been caused by a different local earthquake; for the shock travelled from Lisbon to Madeira in two hours, which agrees with the time which it required to reach other places equally distant.686

Another proposed explanation is the sudden rise of the land, which would cause the sea to immediately retreat from the ancient coastline; and if the shore, after being lifted, were to fall back to its original level, the ocean would come back. However, this theory doesn't explain the facts observed during the Lisbon earthquake; the retreat happened before the wave, not just on the coast of Portugal but also on the island of Madeira and several other locations. If the uplift of the coast of Portugal had caused the retreat, the movement of the waters, when it reached Madeira, would have created a wave before the retreat. Also, the movement of the waters at Madeira couldn't have been caused by a different local earthquake because the shock traveled from Lisbon to Madeira in two hours, which matches the time it took to reach other equally distant places.686

The following is another solution of the problem, which has been offered:—Suppose a portion of the bed of the sea to be suddenly upheaved; the first effect will be to raise over the elevated part a body of water, the momentum of which will carry it much above the level it will afterwards assume, causing a draught or receding of the water from the neighboring coasts, followed immediately by the return of the displaced water, which will also be impelled by its momentum much farther and higher on the coast than its former level.687

The following is another solution to the problem that has been proposed:—Imagine a part of the ocean floor suddenly being lifted; the first effect will be to raise a body of water above the elevated area, with enough momentum to carry it well above the level it will settle at later. This will create a withdrawal of water from nearby shores, quickly followed by the return of the displaced water, which will also be pushed by its momentum much farther and higher up the coast than where it was originally.687

Mr. Darwin, when alluding to similar waves on the coast of Chili, states his opinion, that "the whole phenomenon is due to a common undulation in the water, proceeding from a line or point of disturbance some little way distant. If the waves," he says, "sent off from the paddles of a steam-vessel be watched breaking on the sloping shore of a still river, the water will be seen first to retire two or three feet, and then to return in little breakers, precisely analogous to those consequent on an earthquake." He also adds, that "the earthquake-wave occurs some time after the shock, the water at first retiring both from the shores of the mainland and of outlying islands, and then returning in mountainous breakers. Their size is modified by the form of the neighboring coast; for it is ascertained in South America, that places situated 498 at the head of shoaling bays have suffered most, whereas towns like Valparaiso, seated close on the border of a profound ocean, have never been inundated, though severely shaken by earthquakes."688

Mr. Darwin, in discussing similar waves along the coast of Chile, shares his view that "the whole phenomenon results from a common wave motion in the water, originating from a line or point of disturbance a short distance away. If the waves," he notes, "created by the paddles of a steam vessel are observed breaking on the gentle slope of a calm river, the water will first pull back two or three feet and then come back in small waves, exactly like those that follow an earthquake." He also mentions that "the earthquake wave arrives a little while after the shock, with the water first receding from both the mainland shores and nearby islands, before rushing back in large waves. Their size is influenced by the shape of the nearby coast; it has been confirmed in South America that areas located at the heads of shallow bays have experienced the most damage, while towns like Valparaiso, situated right on the edge of a deep ocean, have never been flooded, even though they have faced strong earthquakes." 498

More recently (February, 1846), Mr. Mallet, in his memoir above cited (p. 475), has endeavored to bring to bear on this difficult subject the more advanced knowledge obtained of late years respecting the true theory of waves. He conceives that when the origin of the shock is beneath the deep ocean, one wave is propagated through the land, and another moving with inferior velocity is formed on the surface of the ocean. This last rolls in upon the land long after the earth-wave has arrived and spent itself. However irreconcilable it may be to our common notions of solid bodies, to imagine them capable of transmitting, with such extreme velocity, motions analogous to tidal waves, it seems nevertheless certain that such undulations are produced, and it is supposed that when the shock passes a given point, each particle of the solid earth describes an ellipse in space. The facility with which all the particles of a solid mass can be made to vibrate may be illustrated, says Gay Lussac, by many familiar examples. If we apply the ear to one end of a long wooden beam, and listen attentively when the other end is struck by a pin's head, we hear the shock distinctly; which shows that every fibre throughout the whole length has been made to vibrate. The rattling of carriages on the pavement shakes the largest edifices; and in the quarries underneath some quarters in Paris, it is found that the movement is communicated through a considerable thickness of rock.689

More recently (February 1846), Mr. Mallet, in his mentioned memoir (p. 475), has tried to apply the more advanced knowledge we've gained in recent years about the true theory of waves to this tricky topic. He believes that when the source of the shock is beneath the deep ocean, one wave travels through the land, while another, moving at a slower speed, forms on the ocean's surface. This surface wave arrives on land long after the ground wave has reached and dissipated. Even though it's hard for us to grasp how solid objects can transmit motions similar to tidal waves at such high speeds, it seems clear that such waves are indeed created, and it's thought that when the shock passes a certain point, each particle of solid earth moves in an elliptical path. The ease with which all particles in a solid mass can be made to vibrate can be demonstrated by several familiar examples, as Gay Lussac notes. If we put our ear to one end of a long wooden beam and listen closely when the other end is struck by a pin's head, we can hear the shock clearly, indicating that every fiber along its length has vibrated. The rattling of carriages on the pavement can shake even the largest buildings; and in the quarries beneath certain parts of Paris, the movement is found to travel through a significant thickness of rock.689

The great sea-wave originating directly over the centre of disturbance is propagated, as Michell correctly stated, in every direction, like the circle upon a pond when a pebble is dropped into it, the different rates at which it moves depending (as he also suggested) on variations in the depth of the water. This wave of the sea, says Mr. Mallet, is raised by the impulse of the shock immediately below it, which in great earthquakes lifts up the ground two or three feet perpendicularly. The velocity of the shock, or earth-wave, is greater because it "depends upon a function of the elasticity of the crust of the earth, whereas the velocity of the sea-wave depends upon a function of the depth of the sea."

The huge sea wave that starts right above the center of the disturbance spreads out in all directions, just like the ripples on a pond when you drop a pebble in it, and the different speeds at which it travels vary based on the water's depth. This sea wave, according to Mr. Mallet, is triggered by the shock beneath it, which during major earthquakes can lift the ground up two or three feet straight up. The speed of the shock, or earth wave, is faster because it relies on the elasticity of the Earth's crust, while the speed of the sea wave is determined by the depth of the sea.

"Although the shock in its passage under the deep ocean gives no trace of its progress, it no sooner gets into soundings or shallow water, than it gives rise to another and smaller wave of the sea. It carries, as it were, upon its back, this lesser aqueous undulation; a long narrow ridge of water which corresponds in form and velocity to itself, being pushed up by the partial elevation of the bottom. It is this small wave, called technically the 'forced sea-wave,' which communicates the earthquake-shock to ships at sea, as if they had struck upon a rock. It breaks upon a coast at the same moment that the shock reaches it, and sometimes 499 it may cause an apparent slight recession from the shore, followed by its flowing up somewhat higher than the usual tide mark: this will happen where the beach is very sloping, as is usual where the sea is shallow, for then the velocity of the low flat earth-wave is such, that it slips as it were, from under the undulation in the fluid above. It does this at the moment of reaching the beach, which it elevates by a vertical height equal to its own, and as instantly lets drop again to its former level."

"Even though the shock moves through the deep ocean without leaving any signs of its passage, as soon as it reaches shallower water, it creates a smaller wave in the sea. This smaller wave rides on the back of the larger one; it's a long, narrow ridge of water that matches the shape and speed of the original wave, pushed up by the partial rise of the ocean floor. This small wave, technically known as the 'forced sea-wave,' conveys the earthquake shock to ships at sea, making it feel like they've hit a rock. It hits the coast at the same time the shock arrives and can sometimes cause a noticeable slight retreat from the shore, followed by the water flowing further up the beach than the usual tide mark. This occurs when the beach is very sloped, which often happens where the sea is shallow, since the speed of the low flat earth-wave is such that it seems to slip underneath the wave on the surface. This happens right as it reaches the shore, raising the beach by a height equal to its own, and then instantly dropping back to its original level."

"While the shock propagated through the solid earth has thus travelled with extra rapidity to the land, the great sea-wave has been following at a slower pace, though advancing at the rate of several miles in a minute. It consists, in the deep ocean, of a long low swell of enormous volume, having an equal slope before and behind, and that so gentle that it might pass under a ship without being noticed. But when it reaches the edge of soundings, its front slope, like that of a tidal wave under similar circumstances, becomes short and steep, while its rear slope is long and gentle. If there be water of some depth close into shore, this great wave may roll in long after the shock, and do little damage; but if the shore be shelving, there will be first a retreat of the water, and then the wave will break upon the beach and roll in far upon the land."690

"While the shock that traveled through the solid earth hit the land quickly, the massive sea wave followed at a slower speed, still moving at several miles per minute. In the deep ocean, it appears as a long, low swell of huge volume, with an even slope in front and behind, gentle enough that it could pass under a ship without being noticed. But when it reaches the edge of the continental shelf, its front slope, like that of a tidal wave in similar situations, becomes short and steep, while its rear slope remains long and gentle. If there's some depth of water close to shore, this massive wave might crash in long after the shock and cause little damage; but if the shore is sloping, there will first be a retreat of the water, and then the wave will break on the beach and roll far inland." 690

The various opinions which have been offered by Michell and later writers, respecting the remote causes of earthquake shocks in the interior of the earth, will more properly be discussed in the thirty-second chapter.

The different views that Michell and later writers have presented about the distant causes of earthquake shocks within the earth will be discussed more appropriately in the thirty-second chapter.

Chili, 1751.—On the 24th of May, 1751, the ancient town of Conception, otherwise called Penco, was totally destroyed by an earthquake, and the sea rolled over it. (See plan of the bay, fig. 70, p. 455.) The ancient port was rendered entirely useless, and the inhabitants built another town about ten miles from the sea-coast, in order to be beyond the reach of similar inundations. At the same time, a colony recently settled on the sea-shore of Juan Fernandez was almost entirely overwhelmed by a wave which broke upon the shore.

Chile, 1751.—On May 24, 1751, the historic town of Concepción, also known as Penco, was completely destroyed by an earthquake, and the sea swept over it. (See plan of the bay, fig. 70, p. 455.) The old port became completely unusable, and the residents constructed a new town about ten miles inland to avoid future flood risks. Meanwhile, a recently established colony on the shoreline of Juan Fernández was nearly wiped out by a wave that crashed onto the beach.

It has been already stated, that in 1835, or eighty-four years after the destruction of Penco, the same coast was overwhelmed by a similar flood from the sea during an earthquake; and it is also known that twenty-one years before (or in 1730), a like wave rolled over these fated shores, in which many of the inhabitants perished. A series of similar catastrophes has also been tracked back as far as the year 1590,691 beyond which we have no memorials save those of oral tradition. Molina, who has recorded the customs and legends of the aborigines, tells us, that the Araucanian Indians, a tribe inhabiting the country between the Andes and the Pacific, including the part now called Chili, "had among them a tradition of a great deluge, in which only a few persons were 500 saved, who took refuge upon a high mountain called Thegtheg, "the thundering," which had three points. Whenever a violent earthquake occurs, these people fly for safety to the mountains, assigning as a reason, that they are fearful, after the shock, that the sea will again return and deluge the world.692

It has already been mentioned that in 1835, or eighty-four years after the destruction of Penco, the same coastline was hit by a similar flood from the sea during an earthquake; it is also known that twenty-one years earlier (in 1730), a wave like this swept over these unfortunate shores, resulting in the loss of many lives. A series of similar disasters has been traced back as far as the year 1590,691 and before that, we have no records except for oral traditions. Molina, who documented the customs and legends of the indigenous people, tells us that the Araucanian Indians, a tribe living in the region between the Andes and the Pacific, including what is now called Chile, "had a tradition of a great flood, in which only a few people were 500 saved, who took refuge on a high mountain called Thegtheg, "the thundering," which had three peaks. Whenever a major earthquake happens, these people head for safety in the mountains, believing that after the shock, the sea will again return and flood the world.692

Notwithstanding the tendency of writers in his day to refer all traditionary inundations to one remote period, Molina remarks that this flood of the Araucanians "was probably very different from that of Noah." We have, indeed, no means of conjecturing how long this same tribe had flourished in Chili, but we can scarcely doubt, that if its experience reached back even for three or four centuries, several inroads of the ocean must have occurred within that period. But the memory of a succession of physical events, similar in kind, though distinct in time, can never be preserved by a people destitute of written annals. Before two or three generations have passed away all dates are forgotten, and even the events themselves, unless they have given origin to some customs, or religious rites and ceremonies. Oftentimes the incidents of many different earthquakes and floods become blended together in the same narrative; and in such cases the single catastrophe is described in terms so exaggerated, or is so disguised by mythological fictions, as to be utterly valueless to the antiquary or philosopher.

Despite the tendency of writers in his time to link all traditional floods to a single ancient event, Molina notes that this flood of the Araucanians "was probably very different from that of Noah." We really have no way of guessing how long this tribe had thrived in Chile, but we can hardly doubt that if their history stretches back even three or four centuries, several ocean incursions must have happened during that time. However, without written records, a people can't preserve the memory of a series of similar physical events that occurred at different times. Within just two or three generations, all dates fade from memory, and even the events themselves become forgotten unless they give rise to some customs or religious rituals. Often, the details of various earthquakes and floods get mixed together in the same story; in these cases, the single disaster is described in such exaggerated terms or obscured by myths that it becomes completely useless to historians or philosophers.

Proofs of elevation of twenty-four feet.—During a late survey of Conception Bay, Captain Beechey and Sir E. Belcher discovered that the ancient harbor, which formerly admitted all large merchant vessels which went round the Cape, is now occupied by a reef of sandstone, certain points of which project above the sea at low water, the greater part being very shallow. A tract of a mile and a half in length, where, according to the report of the inhabitants, the water was formerly four or five fathoms deep, is now a shoal; consisting, as our hydrographers found, of hard sandstone, so that it cannot be supposed to have been formed by recent deposits of the river Biobio, an arm of which carries down loose micaceous sand into the same bay.

Proofs of elevation of twenty-four feet.—During a recent survey of Conception Bay, Captain Beechey and Sir E. Belcher found that the old harbor, which used to allow large merchant ships to pass around the Cape, is now filled with a sandstone reef. Some parts of it stick out above the sea at low tide, and most of it is very shallow. A stretch of one and a half miles that, according to local reports, used to have water that was four or five fathoms deep, is now a sandbar made up of hard sandstone. Therefore, it can’t be assumed that this was created by recent sediment from the Biobio River, which carries loose micaceous sand into the same bay.

It is impossible at this distance of time to affirm that the bed of the sea was uplifted at once to the height of twenty-four feet, during the single earthquake of 1751, because other movements may have occurred subsequently; but it is said, that ever since the shock of 1751, no vessels have been able to approach within a mile and a half of the ancient port of Penco. (See Map, p. 455.) In proof of the former elevation of the coast near Penco our surveyors found above high-water mark an enormous bed of shells of the same species as those now living in the bay, filled with micaceous sand like that which the Biobio now conveys to the bay. These shells, as well as others, which cover the adjoining hills of mica-schist to the height of several hundred feet, have lately been examined by experienced conchologists in London, and identified 501 with those taken at the same time in a living state from the bay and its neighborhood.693

It's hard to say for sure, after all this time, that the ocean floor was raised instantly by twenty-four feet during the earthquake in 1751, since other movements may have happened later; however, it's reported that since the shock of 1751, no ships have been able to come within a mile and a half of the old port of Penco. (See Map, p. 455.) To support the claim of the coastline's earlier elevation near Penco, our surveyors discovered a massive bed of shells above the high-water mark, made up of the same species still found in the bay, embedded in micaceous sand similar to what the Biobio carries to the bay today. These shells, along with others that blanket the nearby mica-schist hills up to several hundred feet high, have recently been examined by skilled conchologists in London and matched with those collected in a living state from the bay and surrounding areas.501

Ulloa, therefore, was perfectly correct in his statement that, at various heights above the sea between Talcahuano and Conception, "mines were found of various sorts of shells used for lime of the very same kinds as those found in the adjoining sea." Among them he mentions the great mussel called Choros, and two others which he describes. Some of these, he says, are entire, and others broken; they occur at the bottom of the sea, in four, six, ten, or twelve fathom water, where they adhere to a sea-plant called Cochayuyo. They are taken in dredges, and have no resemblance to those found on the shore or in shallow water; yet beds of them occur at various heights on the hills. "I was the more pleased with the sight," he adds, "as it appeared to me a convincing proof of the universality of the deluge, although I am not ignorant that some have attributed their position to other causes."694 It has, however, been ascertained that the foundation of the Castle of Penco was so low in 1835, or at so inconsiderable an elevation above the highest spring tides, as to discountenance the idea of any permanent upheaval in modern times, on the site of that ancient port; but no exact measurements or levellings appear as yet to have been made to determine this point, which is the more worthy of investigation, because it may throw some light on an opinion often promulgated of late years, that there is a tendency in the Chilian coast, after each upheaval, to sink gradually and return towards its former position.

Ulloa was completely right when he stated that, at various heights above the sea between Talcahuano and Concepción, "mines were found of various kinds of shells used for lime that are exactly the same as those found in the nearby sea." He mentions the large mussel called Choros and describes two others. Some of these are whole, while others are broken; they are found at the bottom of the sea in four, six, ten, or twelve fathoms of water, where they cling to a sea plant called Cochayuyo. They are collected using dredges and look different from those found on the shore or in shallow water; yet beds of them are found at various elevations on the hills. "I was even more pleased to see this," he adds, "as it seemed to me a strong proof of the universality of the flood, although I know that some attribute their position to other causes." 694 It has, however, been determined that the foundation of the Castle of Penco was very low in 1835, or at a minimal height above the highest spring tides, which undermines the idea of any permanent uplift in modern times at the location of that ancient port; however, no precise measurements or levelings seem to have been made to clarify this, a point that deserves further exploration since it may shed light on a view that has been frequently expressed in recent years, that the Chilian coast tends to gradually sink back to its original position after each uplift.

Peru, 1746.—Peru was visited, on the 28th of October, 1746, by a tremendous earthquake. In the first twenty-four hours, two hundred shocks were experienced. The ocean twice retired and returned impetuously upon the land: Lima was destroyed, and part of the coast near Callao was converted into a bay: four other harbors, among which were Cavalla and Guanape, shared the same fate. There were twenty-three ships and vessels, great and small, in the harbor of Callao, of which nineteen were sunk; and the other four, among which was a frigate called St. Fermin, were carried by the force of the waves to a great distance up the country, and left on dry ground at a considerable height above the sea. The number of inhabitants in this city amounted to four thousand. Two hundred only escaped, twenty-two of whom were saved on a small fragment of the fort of Vera Cruz, which remained as the only memorial of the town after this dreadful inundation. Other portions of its site were completely covered with heaps of sand and gravel.

Peru, 1746.—Peru was hit by a massive earthquake on October 28, 1746. In the first twenty-four hours, there were two hundred aftershocks. The ocean retreated twice and then crashed back onto the land: Lima was destroyed, and a part of the coast near Callao became a bay; four other harbors, including Cavalla and Guanape, faced the same fate. There were twenty-three ships of all sizes in Callao's harbor, of which nineteen sank. The other four, one of which was a frigate called St. Fermin, were pushed far inland by the waves and left on dry land at a significant height above the sea. The city's population was about four thousand. Only two hundred people survived, twenty-two of whom were saved on a small piece of the fort of Vera Cruz, which remained the only reminder of the town after this catastrophic flood. Other parts of the area were completely buried under piles of sand and gravel.

A volcano in Lucanas burst forth the same night, and such quantities of water descended from the cone that the whole country was overflowed; and in the mountain near Pataz, called Conversiones de Caxamarquilla, three other volcanoes burst out, and frightful torrents of water swept down their sides.695

A volcano in Lucanas erupted that same night, and so much water poured out from the cone that the entire area was flooded; and in the mountain near Pataz, known as Conversiones de Caxamarquilla, three other volcanoes erupted, unleashing terrifying torrents of water down their slopes.695

502 There are several records of prior convulsions in Peru, accompanied by similar inroads in the sea, one of which happened fifty-nine years before (in 1687), when the ocean, according to Ulloa, first retired and then returned in a mountainous wave, overwhelming Callao and its environs, with the miserable inhabitants.696 This same wave, according to Lionel Wafer, carried ships a league into the country, and drowned man and beast for fifty leagues along the shore.697 Inundations of still earlier dates are carefully recorded by Ulloa, Wafer, Acosta, and various writers, who describe them as having expended their chief fury, some on one part of the coast and some on another.

502 There are several records of past earthquakes in Peru, accompanied by similar disturbances in the sea. One of these events occurred fifty-nine years earlier (in 1687), when the ocean, according to Ulloa, first receded and then surged back in a massive wave, overwhelming Callao and its surroundings, along with the unfortunate residents.696 This same wave, according to Lionel Wafer, carried ships a league inland and drowned both people and animals for fifty leagues along the coast.697 Earlier floods are thoroughly documented by Ulloa, Wafer, Acosta, and various other writers, who describe them as having unleashed their main force in different areas of the coast.

But all authentic accounts cease when we ascend to the era of the conquest of Peru by the Spaniards. The ancient Peruvians, although far removed from barbarism, were without written annals, and therefore unable to preserve a distinct recollection of a long series of natural events. They had, however, according to Antonio de Herrera, who, in the beginning of the seventeenth century, investigated their antiquities, a tradition, "that many years before the reign of the Incas, at a time when the country was very populous, there happened a great flood; the sea breaking out beyond its bounds, so that the land was covered with water and all the people perished. To this the Guacas, inhabiting the vale of Xausca, and the natives of Chiquito, in the province of Callao, add that some persons remained in the hollows and caves of the highest mountains, who again peopled the land. Others of the mountain people affirm that all perished in the deluge, only six persons being saved on a float, from whom descended all the inhabitants of that country."698

But all genuine records stop when we reach the time of the Spaniards' conquest of Peru. The ancient Peruvians, although not barbaric, had no written history, so they couldn't keep a clear memory of a long series of natural events. According to Antonio de Herrera, who explored their history in the early seventeenth century, there was a tradition that "many years before the reign of the Incas, when the land was very populated, there was a great flood; the sea overflowed its limits, covering the land with water and causing all the people to perish. The Guacas, living in the valley of Xausca, and the natives of Chiquito in the province of Callao, added that some individuals survived in the hollows and caves of the highest mountains and later repopulated the land. Others from the mountains claim that everyone died in the flood, with only six people saved on a raft, from whom all the inhabitants of the country are descended."698

On the mainland near Lima, and on the neighboring island of San Lorenzo, Mr. Darwin found proofs that the ancient bed of the sea had been raised to the height of more than eighty feet above water within the human epoch, strata having been discovered at that altitude, containing pieces of cotton thread and plaited rush, together with sea-weed and marine shells.699 The same author learnt from Mr. Gill, a civil engineer, that he discovered in the interior near Lima, between Casma and Huaraz, the dried-up channel of a large river, sometimes worn through solid rock, which, instead of continually ascending towards its source, has, in one place, a steep downward slope in that direction, for a ridge or line of hills has been uplifted directly across the bed of the stream, which is now arched. By these changes the water has been turned into some other course; and a district, once fertile, and still covered with ruins, and bearing the marks of ancient cultivation, has been converted into a desert.700

On the mainland near Lima, and on the nearby island of San Lorenzo, Mr. Darwin found evidence that the ancient sea bed had been raised more than eighty feet above water during human history, with layers discovered at that height containing bits of cotton thread and woven rush, along with seaweed and marine shells.699 The same author learned from Mr. Gill, a civil engineer, that he found the dried-up channel of a large river in the interior near Lima, between Casma and Huaraz. This channel, sometimes cut through solid rock, doesn't continually rise towards its source; instead, it has a steep drop in one section because a ridge or line of hills has pushed up right across the riverbed, which is now arched. Because of these changes, the water has been redirected, and an area that was once fertile and still has ruins and signs of ancient farming has turned into a desert.700

Java, 1699.—On the 5th of January, 1699, a terrible earthquake visited Java, and no less than 208 considerable shocks were reckoned. 503 Many houses in Batavia were overturned, and the flame and noise of a volcanic eruption were seen and heard in that city, which were afterwards found to proceed from Mount Salek,701 a volcano six days' journey distant. Next morning the Batavian river, which has its rise from that mountain, became very high and muddy, and brought down abundance of bushes and trees, half burnt. The channel of the river being stopped up, the water overflowed the country round the gardens about the town, and some of the streets, so that fishes lay dead in them. All the fish in the river, except the carps, were killed by the mud and turbid water. A great number of drowned buffaloes, tigers, rhinoceroses, deer, apes, and other wild beasts, were brought down by the current; and, "notwithstanding," observes one of the writers, "that a crocodile is amphibious, several of them were found dead among the rest."702

Java, 1699.—On January 5, 1699, a terrible earthquake hit Java, with a total of 208 significant shocks recorded. 503 Many houses in Batavia were toppled, and the fire and sound of a volcanic eruption were seen and heard in that city, which were later discovered to come from Mount Salek,701 a volcano located a six-day journey away. The next morning, the Batavian river, which originates from that mountain, became very high and muddy, carrying down a lot of burnt bushes and trees. The river's channel was blocked, causing the water to flood surrounding gardens and some of the streets, leading to dead fish lying in them. All the fish in the river, except for the carps, were killed by the mud and murky water. A large number of drowned buffaloes, tigers, rhinoceroses, deer, monkeys, and other wild animals were washed away by the current; and, “despite,” notes one of the writers, “the fact that a crocodile is amphibious, several of them were found dead among the others.”702

It is stated that seven hills bounding the river sank down; by which is merely meant, as by similar expressions in the description of the Calabrian earthquakes, seven great landslips. These hills, descending some from one side of the valley and some from the other, filled the channel, and the waters then finding their way under the mass, flowed out thick and muddy. The Tangaran river was also dammed up by nine hills, and in its channel were large quantities of drift trees. Seven of its tributaries also are said to have been "covered up with earth." A high tract of forest land, between the two great rivers before mentioned, is described as having been changed into an open country, destitute of trees, the surface being spread over with fine red clay. This part of the account may, perhaps, merely refer to the sliding down of woody tracts into the valleys, as happened to so many extensive vineyards and olive-grounds in Calabria, in 1783. The close packing of large trees in the Batavian river is represented as very remarkable, and it attests in a striking manner the destruction of soil bordering the valleys which had been caused by floods and landslips.703

It is said that seven hills around the river sank down; this just means, like in similar descriptions of the Calabrian earthquakes, seven major landslides. These hills, some descending from one side of the valley and some from the other, blocked the river channel, and the water, finding its way underneath the mass, flowed out thick and muddy. The Tangaran river was also dammed by nine hills, and its channel was filled with fallen trees. It's also mentioned that seven of its tributaries were "covered up with earth." A high stretch of forest land, between the two major rivers mentioned earlier, is described as turning into open land without trees, with the surface covered in fine red clay. This part of the account might simply refer to the sliding of wooded areas into the valleys, like what happened to many extensive vineyards and olive groves in Calabria in 1783. The dense packing of large trees in the Batavian river is noted as very remarkable, clearly showing the destruction of soil along the valleys caused by floods and landslides.703

Quito, 1698.—In Quito, on the 19th of July, 1698, during an earthquake, a great part of the crater and summit of the volcano Carguairazo fell in, and a stream of water and mud issued from the broken sides of the hill.704

Quito, 1698.—In Quito, on July 19, 1698, during an earthquake, a large section of the crater and peak of the Carguairazo volcano collapsed, causing a flow of water and mud to emerge from the shattered slopes of the hill.704

Sicily, 1693.—Shocks of earthquakes spread over all Sicily in 1693, and on the 11th of January the city of Catania and forty-nine other places were levelled to the ground, and about one hundred thousand people killed. The bottom of the sea, says Vicentino Bonajutus, sank down considerably, both in ports, inclosed bays, and open parts of the coast, and water bubbled up along the shores. Numerous long fissures of various breadths were caused, which threw out sulphurous water; and one of them, in the plain of Catania (the delta of the Simeto), at the distance of four miles from the sea, sent forth water as salt as the sea. The stone buildings of a street in the city of Noto, for the length 504 of half a mile, sank into the ground, and remained hanging on one side. In another street, an opening large enough to swallow a man and horse appeared.705

Sicily, 1693.—In 1693, a series of earthquakes struck all over Sicily, and on January 11th, the city of Catania and forty-nine other places were completely destroyed, resulting in around one hundred thousand fatalities. According to Vicentino Bonajutus, the sea floor sank significantly in ports, enclosed bays, and open coastal areas, causing water to bubble up along the shore. Numerous long cracks of varying widths formed, releasing sulfurous water; one of these, located in the plain of Catania (the delta of the Simeto), about four miles from the sea, discharged water that was as salty as the ocean. In a street in Noto, stone buildings sank into the ground for half a mile and were left leaning at an angle. In another street, a gap large enough to swallow a man and a horse emerged.504

Moluccas, 1693.—The small Isle of Sorea, which consists of one great volcano, was in eruption in the year 1693. Different parts of the cone fell, one after the other, into a deep crater, until almost half the space of the island was converted into a fiery lake. Most of the inhabitants fled to Banda; but great pieces of the mountain continued to fall down, so that the lake of lava became wider; and finally the whole population was compelled to emigrate. It is stated that, in proportion as the burning lake increased in size, the earthquakes were less vehement.706

Moluccas, 1693.—The small Isle of Sorea, which is made up of one massive volcano, erupted in 1693. Different parts of the cone collapsed one after another into a deep crater, until nearly half of the island was transformed into a lake of fire. Most of the residents escaped to Banda; however, large sections of the mountain kept falling, causing the lava lake to expand. Eventually, the entire population had to leave. It's noted that as the burning lake grew larger, the earthquakes became less intense.706

Jamaica, 1692.—In the year 1692, the island of Jamaica was visited by a violent earthquake; the ground swelled and heaved like a rolling sea, and was traversed by numerous cracks, two or three hundred of which were often seen at a time, opening and then closing rapidly again. Many people were swallowed up in these rents; some the earth caught by the middle, and squeezed to death; the heads of others only appeared above ground; and some were first engulfed, and then cast up again with great quantities of water. Such was the devastation, that even in Port Royal, then the capital, where more houses are said to have been left standing than in the whole island besides, three-quarters of the buildings, together with the ground they stood on, sank down with their inhabitants entirely under water.

Jamaica, 1692.—In 1692, the island of Jamaica experienced a violent earthquake; the ground swelled and rolled like a raging sea, with many cracks appearing, two or three hundred of which were often visible at once, opening and closing rapidly. Many people were swallowed up in these fissures; some were trapped in the middle and crushed to death; the heads of others were barely visible above ground; and some were initially engulfed only to be spat out later along with large amounts of water. The destruction was so severe that even in Port Royal, then the capital, where more buildings were said to have survived than anywhere else on the island, three-quarters of the structures, along with the land they occupied, sank completely beneath the water along with their inhabitants.

Subsidence in the harbor.—The large storehouses on the harbor side subsided, so as to be twenty-four, thirty-six, and forty-eight feet under water; yet many of them appear to have remained standing, for it is stated that, after the earthquake, the mast-heads of several ships wrecked in the harbor, together with the chimney-tops of houses, were just seen projecting above the waves. A tract of land round the town, about a thousand acres in extent, sank down in less than one minute, during the first shock, and the sea immediately rolled in. The Swan frigate, which was repairing in the wharf, was driven over the tops of many buildings, and then thrown upon one of the roofs, through which it broke. The breadth of one of the streets is said to have been doubled by the earthquake.

Subsidence in the harbor.—The large warehouses along the harbor sunk, ending up twenty-four, thirty-six, and forty-eight feet underwater; yet many of them seem to still be standing, because reports say that after the earthquake, the mastheads of several ships wrecked in the harbor, along with the tops of chimneys from houses, were barely visible above the waves. A piece of land around the town, covering about a thousand acres, dropped in less than a minute during the initial shock, and the sea flooded in immediately. The Swan frigate, which was under repair at the wharf, was pushed over the tops of many buildings and ended up crashing onto one of the roofs, breaking through it. It's said that the width of one of the streets was doubled due to the earthquake.

According to Sir H. De la Beche, the part of Port Royal described as having sunk was built upon newly formed land, consisting of sand, in which piles had been driven; and the settlement of this loose sand, charged with the weight of heavy houses, may, he suggests, have given rise to the subsidence alluded to.707

According to Sir H. De la Beche, the section of Port Royal that reportedly sank was constructed on newly formed land made of sand, where piles had been driven in; and the settlement of this loose sand, burdened with the weight of heavy buildings, may have caused the subsidence mentioned. 707

There have undoubtedly been instances in Calabria and elsewhere of slides of land on which the houses have still remained standing; and it is possible that such may have been the case at Port Royal. The 505 fact at least of submergence is unquestionable, for I was informed by the late Admiral Sir Charles Hamilton that he frequently saw the submerged houses of Port Royal in the year 1780, in that part of the harbor which lies between the town and the usual anchorage of men-of-war. Bryan Edwards also says, in his history of the West Indies, that in 1793 the ruins were visible in clear weather from the boats which sailed over them.708 Lastly, Lieutenant B. Jeffery, R. N., tells me that, being engaged in a survey between the years 1824 and 1835, he repeatedly visited the site in question, where the depth of the water is from four to six fathoms, and whenever there was but little wind perceived distinct traces of houses. He saw these more clearly when he used the instrument called the "diver's eye," which is let down below the ripple of the wave.709

There have definitely been cases in Calabria and elsewhere where land slides have occurred but the houses still stood. It's possible that this happened in Port Royal as well. The fact that it submerged is indisputable, as I was told by the late Admiral Sir Charles Hamilton that he often saw the submerged houses of Port Royal in 1780, in that part of the harbor between the town and where warships usually anchored. Bryan Edwards also notes in his history of the West Indies that in 1793 the ruins were visible in clear weather from boats that passed over them.708 Finally, Lieutenant B. Jeffery, R. N., informed me that during a survey between 1824 and 1835, he visited the site multiple times, where the water depth ranged from four to six fathoms. Whenever there wasn’t much wind, he was able to see clear traces of houses. He observed these even better when he used the instrument called the "diver's eye," which is lowered below the wave's surface.709

At several thousand places in Jamaica the earth is related to have opened. On the north of the island several plantations, with their inhabitants, were swallowed up, and a lake appeared in their place, covering above a thousand acres, which afterwards dried up, leaving nothing but sand and gravel, without the least sign that there had ever been a house or a tree there. Several tenements at Yallows were buried under land-slips; and one plantation was removed half a mile from its place, the crops continuing to grow upon it uninjured. Between Spanish Town and Sixteen-mile Walk, the high and perpendicular cliffs bounding the river fell in, stopped the passage of the river and flooded the latter place for nine days, so that the people "concluded it had been sunk as Port Royal was." But the flood at length subsided, for the river had found some new passage at a great distance.

In several thousand locations across Jamaica, the ground is said to have opened up. In the northern part of the island, multiple plantations, along with their residents, were swallowed, and a lake formed in their place, covering over a thousand acres. This lake later dried up, leaving only sand and gravel, with no signs that houses or trees had ever existed there. Several buildings in Yallows were buried under landslides, and one plantation was moved half a mile from its original location, with the crops still growing on it unharmed. Between Spanish Town and Sixteen-mile Walk, the steep cliffs along the river collapsed, blocking the river’s flow and flooding the latter area for nine days, leading people to believe it had been submerged like Port Royal. Eventually, the flood receded as the river found a new route far away.

Mountains shattered.—The Blue and other of the highest mountains are declared to have been strangely torn and rent. They appeared shattered and half-naked, no longer affording a fine green prospect, as before, but stripped of their woods and natural verdure. The rivers on these mountains first ceased to flow for about twenty-four hours, and then brought down into the sea, at Port Royal and other places, several hundred thousand tons of timber, which looked like floating islands on the ocean. The trees were in general barked, most of their branches having been torn off in the descent. It is particularly remarked in this, as in the narratives of so many earthquakes, that fish were taken in great numbers on the coast during the shocks. The correspondents of Sir Hans Sloane, who collected with care the accounts of eye-witnesses of the catastrophe, refer constantly to subsidences, and some supposed the whole of Jamaica to have sunk down.710

Mountains shattered.—The Blue and other high mountains were strangely torn apart. They looked broken and bare, no longer offering the beautiful green landscape they used to, but stripped of their trees and natural greenery. The rivers on these mountains first stopped flowing for about twenty-four hours, and then carried several hundred thousand tons of timber into the sea at Port Royal and other locations, which appeared like floating islands on the ocean. The trees were mostly stripped of their bark, and many of their branches had been ripped off during the fall. It’s particularly noted here, as in many earthquake accounts, that fish were caught in large numbers along the coast during the tremors. The correspondents of Sir Hans Sloane, who carefully gathered the accounts of eyewitnesses of the disaster, frequently mentioned subsidences, and some believed that all of Jamaica had sunk down.710

Reflections on the amount of change in the last one hundred and sixty years.—I have now only enumerated some few of the earthquakes of the last 160 years, respecting which facts illustrative of geological inquiries are on record. Even if my limits permitted, it would be an unprofitable 506 task to examine all the obscure and ambiguous narratives of similar events of earlier epochs; although, if the places were now examined by geologists well practised in the art of interpreting the monuments of physical changes, many events which have happened within the historical era might doubtless be still determined with precision. It must not be imagined that, in the above sketch of the occurrences of a short period, I have given an account of all, or even the greater part, of the mutations which the earth has undergone by the agency of subterranean movements. Thus, for example, the earthquake of Aleppo, in the present century, and of Syria, in the middle of the eighteenth, would doubtless have afforded numerous phenomena, of great geological importance, had those catastrophes been described by scientific observers. The shocks in Syria in 1759, were protracted for three months, throughout a space of ten thousand square leagues: an area compared to which that of the Calabrian earthquake in 1783 was insignificant. Accon, Saphat, Balbeck, Damascus, Sidon, Tripoli, and many other places, were almost entirely levelled to the ground. Many thousands of the inhabitants perished in each; and, in the valley of Balbeck alone, 20,000 men are said to have been victims to the convulsion. In the absence of scientific accounts, it would be as irrelevant to our present purpose to enter into a detailed account of such calamities, as to follow the track of an invading army, to enumerate the cities burnt or rased to the ground, and reckon the number of individuals who perished by famine or the sword.

Reflections on the amount of change in the last one hundred and sixty years.—I have only mentioned a few of the earthquakes from the last 160 years, for which there are recorded facts relevant to geological studies. Even if I had the space, it would be unhelpful to delve into all the vague and unclear accounts of similar events from earlier times; however, if geologists skilled in interpreting evidence of physical changes were to examine those places today, many events from the historical period could likely still be precisely identified. It shouldn't be assumed that the brief overview I've provided of recent occurrences captures all, or even most, of the changes the earth has experienced due to underground movements. For instance, the earthquake in Aleppo this century and the one in Syria in the mid-eighteenth century would certainly have revealed many significant geological features had they been documented by scientific observers. The shocks in Syria in 1759 lasted for three months across an area of ten thousand square leagues, which is insignificant compared to the area affected by the Calabrian earthquake in 1783. Accon, Saphat, Balbeck, Damascus, Sidon, Tripoli, and many other locations were nearly completely flattened. Many thousands of residents died in each place; in the valley of Balbeck alone, it’s said 20,000 people were victims of the disaster. Without scientific accounts, detailing such tragedies would be as irrelevant to our current discussion as tracing the path of an invading army, listing the cities that were burned or destroyed, and counting the number of people who died from famine or violence.

Deficiency of historical records.—If such, then, be the amount of ascertained changes in the last 160 years, notwithstanding the extreme deficiency of our records during that brief period, how important must we presume the physical revolutions to have been in the course of thirty or forty centuries, during which some countries habitually convulsed by earthquakes have been peopled by civilized nations! Towns engulfed during one earthquake may, by repeated shocks, have sunk to great depths beneath the surface, while the ruins remain as imperishable as the hardest rocks in which they are inclosed. Buildings and cities, submerged, for a time, beneath seas or lakes, and covered with sedimentary deposits, must, in some places, have been re-elevated to considerable heights above the level of the ocean. The signs of these events have, probably, been rendered visible by subsequent mutations, as by the encroachments of the sea upon the coast, by deep excavations made by torrents and rivers, by the opening of new ravines, and chasms, and other effects of natural agents, so active in districts agitated by subterranean movements.

Deficiency of historical records.—If this is the extent of the changes we’ve determined over the last 160 years, despite our significant lack of records during that short time, we can only imagine how significant the physical changes must have been over the span of thirty or forty centuries, during which some regions regularly shaken by earthquakes have been inhabited by advanced civilizations! Towns swallowed during an earthquake may, due to repeated shocks, have sunk deep below the surface, while their ruins stay as lasting as the toughest rocks they are embedded in. Buildings and cities, temporarily submerged beneath seas or lakes and covered with layers of sediment, must have been raised to significant heights above sea level in some areas. The evidence of these events has likely become visible through later changes, such as the sea encroaching on the coast, the deep cuts made by streams and rivers, the creation of new ravines and gorges, and other effects of natural forces, which are very active in areas affected by underground movements.

If it be asked why, if such wonderful monuments exist, so few have hitherto been brought to light, we reply—because they have not been searched for. In order to rescue from oblivion the memorials of former occurrences, the inquirer must know what he may reasonably expect to discover, and under what peculiar local circumstances. He must be acquainted with the action and effect of physical causes, in order to recognize, 507 explain, and describe correctly the phenomena when they present themselves.

If you’re wondering why so few amazing monuments have been discovered so far, it’s because they haven’t been actively searched for. To uncover the memories of past events, the researcher needs to know what to realistically expect to find and the specific local conditions involved. They should understand how physical factors work to identify, explain, and accurately describe the phenomena when they appear. 507

The best known of the great volcanic regions, of which the boundaries were sketched in the twenty-second chapter, is that which includes Southern Europe, Northern Africa, and Central Asia; yet nearly the whole, even of this region, must be laid down, in a geological map, as "Terra Incognita." Even Calabria may be regarded as unexplored, as also Spain, Portugal, the Barbary States, the Ionian Isles, Asia Minor, Cyprus, Syria, and the countries between the Caspian and Black seas. We are, in truth, beginning to obtain some insight into one small spot of that great zone of volcanic disturbance, the district around Naples; a tract by no means remarkable for the violence of the earthquakes which have convulsed it.

The most well-known of the major volcanic regions, the boundaries of which were outlined in the twenty-second chapter, includes Southern Europe, Northern Africa, and Central Asia; however, almost the entire area, even this region, must be marked on a geological map as "Terra Incognita." Even Calabria can be considered unexplored, just like Spain, Portugal, the Barbary States, the Ionian Islands, Asia Minor, Cyprus, Syria, and the lands between the Caspian and Black seas. In reality, we are starting to gain some understanding of one small area within that vast zone of volcanic activity, specifically the region around Naples; a place that is not particularly noted for the severity of the earthquakes that have affected it.

If, in this part of Campania, we are enabled to establish that considerable changes in the relative level of land and sea have taken place since the Christian era, it is all that we could have expected; and it is to recent antiquarian and geological research, not to history, that we are principally indebted for the information. I shall now proceed to lay before the reader some of the results of modern investigations in the Bay of Baiæ and the adjoining coast.

If we can establish in this part of Campania that significant changes in the relative levels of land and sea have occurred since the Christian era, it’s exactly what we might expect. We owe this information mainly to recent archaeological and geological research, not to history. I will now present some of the findings from modern investigations in the Bay of Baiæ and the nearby coast.

PROOFS OF ELEVATION AND SUBSIDENCE IN THE BAY OF BAIÆ.
Fig. 86.Ground plan of the coast of the Bay of Baiae, in the environs of Puzzuoli.

Ground plan of the coast of the Bay of Baiæ, in the environs of Puzzuoli

Ground plan of the coast of the Bay of Baiae, near Pozzuoli

Temple of Jupiter Serapis.—This celebrated monument of antiquity, a representation of which is given in the frontispiece,711 affords in itself alone, unequivocal evidence that the relative level of land and sea has changed twice at Puzzuoli since the Christian era; and each movement, 508 both of elevation and subsidence, has exceeded twenty feet. Before examining these proofs, I may observe, that a geological examination of the coast of Baiæ, both on the north and south of Puzzuoli, establishes, in the most satisfactory manner, an elevation, at no remote period, of more than twenty feet, and, at one point, of more than thirty feet; and the evidence of this change would have been complete, if even the temple had, to this day, remained undiscovered.

Temple of Jupiter Serapis.—This famous ancient monument, shown in the frontispiece,711 provides clear evidence that the land and sea levels in Puzzuoli have changed two times since the Christian era. Each shift, whether upward or downward, has been over twenty feet. Before we look into these proofs, I should point out that a geological survey of the Baiæ coast, both north and south of Puzzuoli, clearly shows an elevation of over twenty feet at a not-so-distant time, and at one spot, over thirty feet. The evidence of this change would have been complete even if the temple had remained undiscovered until today.

Coast south of Puzzuoli.—If we coast along the shore from Naples to Puzzuoli, we find, on approaching the latter place, that the lofty and precipitous cliffs of indurated tuff, resembling that of which Naples is built, retire slightly from the sea; and that a low level tract of fertile land, of a very different aspect, intervenes between the present sea-beach and what was evidently the ancient line of coast.

Coast south of Puzzuoli.—If we sail along the shore from Naples to Puzzuoli, as we get closer to Puzzuoli, we notice that the tall and steep cliffs made of hardened tuff, similar to the material Naples is built from, pull back a bit from the sea. In between the current shoreline and what was clearly the old coast, there's a low, fertile area of land that looks quite different.

The inland cliff may be seen opposite the small island of Nisida, about two miles and a half southeast of Puzzuoli (see Map, fig. 40, p. 361), where, at the height of thirty-two feet above the level of the sea, Mr. Babbage observed an ancient mark, such as might have been worn by the waves; and, upon farther examination, discovered that, along that line, the face of the perpendicular rock, consisting of very hard tuff, was covered with barnacles (Balanus sulcatus, Lamk.), and drilled by boring testacea. Some of the hollows of the lithodomi contained the shells; Fig. 87.Antiquities on hill S. E. of Puzzuoli. a, Antiquities on hill S. E. of Puzzuoli
     (see ground plan, fig. 86).

b, Ancient cliff now inland.
c, Terrace composed of recent
    submarine deposit.
while others were filled with the valves of a species of Area.712 Nearer to Puzzuoli, the inland cliff is eighty feet high, and as perpendicular as if it was still undermined by the waves. At its base, a new deposit, constituting the fertile tract above alluded to, attains a height of about twenty feet above the sea; and, since it is composed of regular sedimentary deposits, containing marine shells, its position proves that, subsequently to its formation, there has been a change of more than twenty feet in the relative level of land and sea.

The inland cliff can be seen across from the small island of Nisida, about two and a half miles southeast of Puzzuoli (see Map, fig. 40, p. 361). Here, at a height of thirty-two feet above sea level, Mr. Babbage noticed an ancient mark, likely worn by the waves. Upon further inspection, he found that along that line, the face of the steep rock, made of very hard tuff, was covered with barnacles (Balanus sulcatus, Lamk.) and bored by drilling creatures. Some of the hollows made by the lithodomi contained shells; Fig. 87.Antiquities on hill SE of Puzzuoli. a, Antiquities on the southeast hill of Puzzuoli
     (see ground plan, __A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__).

b, Ancient cliff now located inland.
c, Terrace formed by recent
    submarine deposits.
while others contained valves from a species of Area.712 Closer to Puzzuoli, the inland cliff rises eighty feet high and is as vertical as if it were still being eroded by the waves. At its base, a new deposit forms the fertile area mentioned earlier, reaching about twenty feet above sea level; and since it consists of regular sedimentary layers containing marine shells, its position indicates that there has been a change of more than twenty feet in the relative level of land and sea since its formation.

The sea encroaches on these new incoherent strata; and as the soil is valuable, a wall has been built for its protection; but when I visited the spot in 1828, the waves had swept away part of this rampart, and exposed to view a regular series of strata of tuff, more or less argillaceous, alternating with beds of pumice and lapilli, and containing great abundance of marine shells, of species now common on this coast, and amongst them Cardium rusticum, Ostrea edulis, Donax trunculus, Lamk., and others. The strata vary from about a foot to a foot and a half in thickness, and one of them contains abundantly remains of works of art, tiles, squares of mosaic pavement of different colors, and small sculptured ornaments, 510 perfectly uninjured. Intermixed with these I collected some teeth of the pig and ox. These fragments of building occur below as well as above strata containing marine shells. Puzzuoli itself stands chiefly on a promontory of the older tufaceous formation, which cuts off the new deposit, although I detected a small patch of the latter in a garden under the town.

The sea is gradually taking over these new, disorganized layers of land; since the soil is valuable, a wall has been built to protect it. However, when I visited in 1828, the waves had washed away part of this barrier, revealing a clear sequence of tuff layers, which are more or less clay-like, alternating with beds of pumice and small volcanic stones, and filled with a lot of marine shells, including species that are now common along this coast, such as Cardium rusticum, Ostrea edulis, Donax trunculus, Lamk., and others. The layers vary in thickness from about one foot to one and a half feet, and one of them has a lot of artifacts, tiles, colorful mosaic pieces, and small sculpted decorations, 510 all in excellent condition. Along with these, I found some teeth from pigs and cows. These building remains can be found both below and above the layers with marine shells. Puzzuoli itself is mainly situated on a ridge of the older tuff formation, which separates it from the newer deposits, although I did find a small area of the latter in a garden below the town.

Fig. 88.
VIEW OF BAY OF BAIÆ.

Ruins of a mole, called Caligula's Bridge,.
1. Puzzuoli. 2. Temple of Serapis. 3. Caligula's Bridge. 4. Monte Barbaro. 5. Monte Nuovo.
6. Baths of Nero. 7. Baiæ. 8. Castle of Baiæ. 9. Bauli. 10. Cape Misenum.
11. Mount Epomeo in Ischia. 12. South Part of Ischia.  

From the town the ruins of a mole, called Caligula's Bridge, run out into the sea (see fig. 88, p. 509).713 This mole, which is believed to be eighteen centuries old, consists of a number of piers and arches, thirteen of which are now standing, and two others appear to have been overthrown. Mr. Babbage found, on the sixth pier, perforations of lithodomi four feet above the level of the sea; and, near the termination of the mole on the last pier but one, marks of the same, ten feet above the level of the sea, together with great numbers of balani and flustra. The depth of the sea, at a very small distance from most of the piers, is from thirty to fifty feet.

From the town, the ruins of a pier, known as Caligula's Bridge, stretch out into the sea (see fig. 88, p. 509).713 This pier, which is thought to be eighteen centuries old, consists of several piers and arches, thirteen of which are still standing, while two others seem to have collapsed. Mr. Babbage discovered, on the sixth pier, holes made by lithodomi four feet above sea level; and near the end of the pier, on the penultimate one, there are similar marks ten feet above sea level, along with many balani and flustra. The sea depth, just a short distance from most of the piers, ranges from thirty to fifty feet.

Fig. 89.Coast north of Puzzuoli.

a, Remains of Cicero's villa, N. side of Puzzuoli.714

a, Remains of Cicero's villa, North side of Puzzuoli.714

b, Ancient cliff now inland.

b, Ancient cliff now on land.

c, Terrace (called La Starza) composed of recent submarine deposits.

c, Terrace (known as La Starza) made up of recent underwater deposits.

d, Temple of Serapis.

Temple of Serapis.

Coast north of Puzzuoli.—If we then pass to the north of Puzzuoli, and examine the coast between that town and Monte Nuovo, we find a repetition of analogous phenomena. The sloping sides of Monte Barbaro slant down within a short distance of the coast, and terminate in an inland cliff of moderate elevation, to which the geologist perceives at once that the sea must, at some former period, have extended. Between this cliff and the sea is a low plain or terrace, called La Starza (c, fig. 89), corresponding to that before described on the southeast of the town; and as the sea encroaches rapidly, fresh sections of the strata may readily be obtained, of which the annexed is an example.

Coast north of Puzzuoli.—If we head north of Puzzuoli and look at the coast between that town and Monte Nuovo, we notice similar patterns. The sloping sides of Monte Barbaro drop down close to the coast and end in an inland cliff of moderate height, which clearly indicates to the geologist that the sea must have extended there in the past. Between this cliff and the sea is a low plain or terrace called La Starza (c, fig. 89), similar to the one described earlier southeast of the town; and as the sea encroaches quickly, new sections of the layers can easily be observed, of which the attached example illustrates.

Section on the shore north of the town of Puzzuoli:—

Section on the shore north of the town of Puzzuoli:—

  Ft. In.
1. Vegetable soil 1   0  
2. Horizontal beds of pumice and scoriæ, with broken fragments of unrolled bricks, bones of animals, and marine shells 1   6  
3. Beds of lapilli, containing abundance of marine shells, principally Cardium rusticum, Donax trunculus, Lam., Ostrea edulis, Triton cutaceum, Lam., and Buccinum serratum, Brocchi, the beds varying in thickness from one to eighteen inches 10   0  
4. Argillaceous tuff, containing bricks and fragments of buildings not rounded by attrition. 1   6  

511 The thickness of many of these beds varies greatly as we trace them along the shore, and sometimes the whole group rises to a greater height than at the point above described. The surface of the tract which they compose appears to slope gently upwards towards the base of the old cliffs.

511 The thickness of many of these layers changes a lot as we follow them along the shore, and sometimes the entire group reaches a greater height than mentioned earlier. The surface of the area they form seems to slope gently upward toward the base of the old cliffs.

Now, if such appearances presented themselves on the coast of England, a geologist might endeavor to seek an explanation in some local change in the set of the tides and currents: but there are scarce any tides in the Mediterranean; and, to suppose the sea to have sunk generally from twenty to twenty-five feet since the shores of Campania were covered with sumptuous buildings is an hypothesis obviously untenable. The observations, indeed, made during modern surveys on the moles and cothons (docks) constructed by the ancients in various ports of the Mediterranean, have proved that there has been no sensible variation of level in that sea during the last two thousand years.715

Now, if such situations appeared along the coast of England, a geologist might try to find an explanation in some local change in the tides and currents. However, there are hardly any tides in the Mediterranean, and to believe that the sea has generally dropped by twenty to twenty-five feet since the shores of Campania were lined with lavish buildings is an obviously ridiculous idea. In fact, modern surveys of the moles and cothons (docks) built by the ancients in various Mediterranean ports have shown that there has been no significant change in sea level in that area over the last two thousand years.715

Thus we arrive, without the aid of the celebrated temple, at the conclusion, that the recent marine deposit at Puzzuoli was upraised in modern times above the level of the sea, and that not only this change of position, but the accumulation of the modern strata, was posterior to the destruction of many edifices, of which they contain the imbedded remains. If we next examine the evidence afforded by the temple itself, it appears, from the most authentic accounts, that the three pillars now standing erect continued, down to the middle of the last century, almost buried in the new marine strata (c, fig. 89). The upper part of each protruding several feet above the surface was concealed by bushes, and had not attracted, until the year 1749, the notice of antiquaries; but, when the soil was removed in 1750, they were seen to form part of the remains of a splendid edifice, the pavement of which was still preserved, and upon it lay a number of columns of African breccia and of granite. The original plan of the building could be traced distinctly: it was of a quadrangular form, seventy feet in diameter, and the roof had been supported by forty-six noble columns, twenty-four of granite and the rest of marble. The large court was surrounded by apartments, supposed to have been used as bathing-rooms; for a thermal spring, still used for medicinal purposes, issues just behind the building, and the water of this spring appears to have been originally conveyed by a marble duct, still extant, into the chambers, and then across the pavement by a groove an inch or two deep, to a conduit made of Roman brickwork, by which it gained the sea.

So, we conclude, without relying on the famous temple, that the recent marine deposit at Puzzuoli was raised in modern times above sea level. Not only this shift in position, but also the buildup of modern layers occurred after the destruction of many buildings, remnants of which they contain. If we examine the evidence from the temple itself, it seems from the most reliable accounts that the three pillars currently standing had remained almost buried in the new marine layers until the middle of last century (c, fig. 89). The upper parts of these pillars, sticking out several feet above the surface, were hidden by bushes and had not caught the attention of antiquarians until 1749. However, when the soil was cleared in 1750, it became clear that they were part of the remains of a magnificent structure, with the pavement still intact, and scattered columns of African breccia and granite on top of it. The original plan of the building was distinctly visible: it was quadrangular, seventy feet in diameter, with a roof supported by forty-six impressive columns, twenty-four made of granite and the rest of marble. The large courtyard was surrounded by rooms believed to be used as baths, as a thermal spring, still in use for medicinal purposes, flows just behind the building. The water from this spring seems to have originally been channeled through a marble duct, which still exists, into the rooms, and then across the pavement through a groove one or two inches deep, leading to a conduit made of Roman bricks that directed it to the sea.

Many antiquaries have entered into elaborate discussions as to the deity to which this edifice was consecrated. It is admitted that, among other images found in excavating the ruins, there was one of the god Serapis; and at Puzzuoli a marble column was dug up, on which was carved an ancient inscription, of the date of the building of Rome 648 (or B. C. 105), entitled "Lex parieti faciundo." This inscription, written 512 in very obscure Latin, sets forth a contract, between the municipality of the town, and a company of builders who undertook to keep in repair certain public edifices, the Temple of Serapis being mentioned amongst the rest, and described as being near or towards the sea, "mare vorsum." Sir Edmund Head, after studying, in 1828, the topography and antiquities of this district, and the Greek, Roman, and Italian writers on the subject, informed me, that at Alexandria, on the Nile, the chief seat of the worship of Serapis, there was a Serapeum of the same form as this temple at Puzzuoli, and surrounded in like manner by chambers, in which the devotees were accustomed to pass the night, in the hope of receiving during sleep a revelation from the god, as to the nature and cure of their diseases. Hence it was very natural that the priests of Serapis, a pantheistic divinity, who, among other usurpations, had appropriated to himself the attributes of Esculapius, should regard the hot spring as a suitable appendage to the temple, although the original Serapeum of Alexandria could boast no such medicinal waters. Signor Carelli716 and others, in objecting to these views, have insisted on the fact, that the worship of Serapis, which we know prevailed at Rome in the days of Catullus (in the first century before Christ), was prohibited by the Roman Senate, during the reign of the Emperor Tiberius. But there is little doubt that, during the reigns of that emperor's successors, the shrines of the Egyptian god were again thronged by zealous votaries; and in no place more so than at Puteoli (now Puzzuoli), one of the principal marts for the produce of Alexandria.

Many historians have had detailed discussions about which deity this building was dedicated to. It's accepted that, among other statues found while digging through the ruins, there was one of the god Serapis; and at Puzzuoli, a marble column was unearthed with an ancient inscription dating back to the founding of Rome 648 (or B. C. 105), titled "Lex parieti faciundo." This inscription, written in very obscure Latin, outlines an agreement between the town's government and a group of builders who were responsible for maintaining certain public buildings, including the Temple of Serapis, which was noted to be near the sea, "mare vorsum." Sir Edmund Head, after studying the geography and ancient sites of this area, along with Greek, Roman, and Italian writings on the topic in 1828, informed me that in Alexandria, on the Nile, the primary location for the worship of Serapis had a Serapeum that resembled this temple in Puzzuoli and was similarly surrounded by rooms where devotees would spend the night, hoping to receive divine revelations about their illnesses while they slept. Therefore, it made sense that the priests of Serapis, a god with pantheistic qualities who, among other claims, had taken on the attributes of Esculapius, would consider the hot spring a fitting addition to the temple, even though the original Serapeum in Alexandria did not have such healing waters. Signor Carelli716 and others, opposing these views, have pointed out that the worship of Serapis was banned in Rome during the time of Catullus (in the first century B.C.) by the Roman Senate when Tiberius was emperor. However, it's widely believed that during the reigns of Tiberius's successors, the shrines dedicated to the Egyptian god were once again filled with devoted worshippers, especially at Puteoli (now Puzzuoli), which was one of the main markets for goods from Alexandria.

Without entering farther into an inquiry which is not strictly geological, I shall designate this valuable relic of antiquity by its generally received name, and proceed to consider the memorials of physical changes inscribed on the three standing columns in most legible characters by the hand of Nature. (See Frontispiece.) These pillars, which have been carved each out of a single block of marble, are forty feet three inches and a half in height. A horizontal fissure nearly intersects one of the columns; the other two are entire. They are all slightly out of the perpendicular, inclining somewhat to the southwest, that is, towards the sea.717 Their surface is smooth and uninjured to the height of about twelve feet above their pedestals. Above this is a zone, about nine feet in height, where the marble has been pierced by a species of marine perforating bivalve—Lithodomus, Cuv.718 The holes of these animals are pear-shaped, the external opening being minute, and gradually increasing downwards. At the bottom of the cavities, many shells are still found, notwithstanding the great numbers that have been 513 taken out by visitors; in many the valves of a species of arca, an animal which conceals itself in small hollows, occur. The perforations are so considerable in depth and size, that they manifest a long-continued abode of the lithodomi in the columns, for, as the inhabitant grows older and increases in size, it bores a larger cavity, to correspond with the increased magnitude of its shell. We must, consequently, infer a long-continued immersion of the pillars in sea-water, at a time when the lower part was covered up and protected by marine, fresh-water, and volcanic strata, afterwards to be described, and by the rubbish of buildings; the highest part, at the same time, projecting above the waters, and being consequently weathered, but not materially injured. (See fig. 90, p. 514.)

Without delving deeper into an inquiry that isn't strictly geological, I'll refer to this valuable ancient artifact by its commonly accepted name and move on to examine the physical changes recorded on the three standing columns in clear detail by Nature herself. (See Frontispiece.) These pillars, each carved from a single block of marble, stand forty feet three and a half inches tall. A horizontal crack nearly cuts through one of the columns; the other two are intact. They all lean slightly, tilting a bit to the southwest, toward the sea. Their surface is smooth and undamaged up to about twelve feet above their bases. Above this point is a zone, around nine feet high, where the marble has been drilled by a type of marine boring bivalve—Lithodomus, Cuv. The holes made by these creatures are pear-shaped, with a tiny external opening that widens as you go deeper. Many shells are still found at the bottom of these cavities, despite the large numbers that visitors have removed; in many of them, you'll find the shells of a species of arca, a creature that hides in small depressions. The perforations are deep and wide enough to suggest that the lithodomi lived in the columns for a long time, as they grow older and larger, boring larger cavities to match the increasing size of their shells. Therefore, we must conclude that the pillars were immersed in seawater for an extended period, while the lower parts were covered and protected by marine, freshwater, and volcanic layers, which will be described later, as well as debris from buildings; the upper parts, meanwhile, were above water and weathered, but not significantly damaged. (See fig. 90, p. 514.)

On the pavement of the temple lie some columns of marble, which are also perforated in certain parts; one, for example, to the length of eight feet, while, for the length of four feet, it is uninjured. Several of these broken columns are eaten into, not only on the exterior, but on the cross fracture, and, on some of them, other marine animals (serpulæ, &c.) have fixed themselves.719 All the granite pillars are untouched by lithodomi. The platform of the temple, which is not perfectly even, was, when I visited it in 1828, about one foot below high-water mark (for there are small tides in the bay of Naples); and the sea, which was only one hundred feet distant, soaked through the intervening soil. The upper part of the perforations, therefore, were at least twenty-three feet above highwater mark; and it is clear that the columns must have continued for a long time in an erect position, immersed in salt water, and then the submerged portion must have been upraised to the height of about twenty-three feet above the level of the sea.

On the pavement of the temple, there are some marble columns that are also broken in certain areas; one, for instance, is eight feet long while another part is four feet long and intact. Several of these damaged columns are worn down, not just on the surface but also on the broken ends, and some have other marine organisms (like serpulæ, etc.) attached to them.719 All the granite pillars remain untouched by lithodomi. The temple's platform, which isn’t perfectly level, was about one foot below high water mark when I visited in 1828 (since there are small tides in the Bay of Naples), and the sea, which was only a hundred feet away, soaked through the soil in between. Therefore, the top part of the holes was at least twenty-three feet above high water mark; it’s clear that the columns must have been standing upright for a long time while submerged in saltwater, and then the submerged part must have been lifted to about twenty-three feet above sea level.

By excavations carried on in 1828, below the marble pavement on which the columns stand, another costly pavement of mosaic was found, at the depth of about five feet below the upper one (a, b, fig. 90). The existence of these two pavements, at different levels, clearly implies some subsidence previously to the building of the more modern temple which had rendered it necessary to construct the new floor at a higher level.

By excavations conducted in 1828, beneath the marble floor where the columns are located, another expensive mosaic floor was discovered, about five feet below the upper one (a, b, fig. 90). The presence of these two floors at different levels clearly indicates some settling that occurred before the construction of the more modern temple, which made it necessary to build the new floor at a higher level.

Fig. 90.Temple of Serapis.

Temple of Serapis at its period of greatest depression.

Temple of Serapis at its lowest point.

a b, Ancient mosaic pavement. e e, Freshwater calcareous deposit.
c c, Dark marine incrustation. f f, Second filling up.
d d, First filling up, shower of ashes. A, Stadium.

We have already seen (p. 512) that a temple of Serapis existed long before the Christian era. The change of level just mentioned must have taken place some time before the end of the second century, for inscriptions have been found in the temple, from which we learn that Septimius Severus adorned its walls with precious marbles, between the years 194 and 211 of our era, and the emperor Alexander Severus displayed the like munificence between the years 222 and 235.720 From that era there is an entire dearth of historical information for a period of more than twelve centuries, except the significant fact that Alaric and his Goths sacked Puzzuoli in 456, and that Genseric did the like in 545, A. D. Yet we have fortunately a series of natural archives self-registered during the 514 dark ages, by which many events which occurred in and about the temple are revealed to us. These natural records consist partly of deposits, which envelop the pillars below the zone of lithodomous perforations, and partly of those which surround the outer walls of the temple. Mr. Babbage, after a minute examination of these, has shown (see p. 507, note) that incrustations on the walls of the exterior chambers and on the floor of the building demonstrate that the pavement did not sink down suddenly, but was depressed by a gradual movement. The sea first entered the court or atrium and mingled its waters partially with those of the hot spring. From this brackish medium a dark calcareous precipitate (c c, fig. 90) was thrown down, which became, in the course of time, more than two feet thick, including some serpulæ in it. The presence of these annelids teaches us that the water was salt or brackish. After this period the temple was filled up with an irregular mass of volcanic tuff (d d, fig. 90), probably derived from an eruption of the neighboring crater of the Solfatara, to the height of from five to nine feet above the pavement. Over this again a purely freshwater deposit of carbonate of lime (e e, fig. 90) accumulated with an uneven bottom since it necessarily accommodated itself to the irregular outline of the upper surface of the volcanic shower before thrown down. The top of the same deposit (a freshwater limestone) was perfectly even and flat, bespeaking an ancient water level. It is suggested by Mr. Babbage that this freshwater lake may have been caused by the fall of ashes which choked up the channel previously communicating with the sea, so that the hot spring threw down calcareous matter in the atrium, without any marine intermixture. To the freshwater limestone succeeded another irregular mass of volcanic ashes and rubbish (f f, fig. 90), some of it perhaps washed in by the waves of the sea during a storm, its surface rising to ten or eleven feet above the pavement. And thus we arrive at the period of greatest depression expressed in the accompanying diagram, when the lower half of the pillars were enveloped in the deposits above enumerated, and the uppermost twenty feet were exposed in the atmosphere, the remaining or middle portion, about nine feet long, being for years immersed in salt 515 water and drilled by perforating bivalves. After this period other strata, consisting of showers of volcanic ashes and materials washed in during storms, covered up the pillars to the height in some places of thirty-five feet above the pavement. The exact time when these enveloping masses were heaped up, and how much of them were formed during submergence, and how much after the re-elevation of the temple, cannot be made out with certainty.

We have already seen (p. 512) that a temple of Serapis existed long before the Christian era. The change in level mentioned earlier must have occurred sometime before the end of the second century, because inscriptions found in the temple inform us that Septimius Severus decorated its walls with precious marbles between the years 194 and 211 AD, and the emperor Alexander Severus showed similar generosity between the years 222 and 235.720 From that time, there is a complete lack of historical information for over twelve centuries, except for the notable fact that Alaric and his Goths sacked Puzzuoli in 456, and Genseric did the same in 545, A.D. Fortunately, we have a series of natural records that have been self-registered during the dark ages, revealing many events that took place in and around the temple. These natural records consist partly of layers covering the pillars below the area with lithodomous perforations, and partly of layers surrounding the temple's outer walls. Mr. Babbage, after a detailed examination of these, has shown (see p. 507, note) that the crust on the walls of the exterior chambers and on the floor of the building indicates that the pavement did not collapse suddenly, but was gradually depressed. The sea first entered the court or atrium and partially mixed its waters with those of the hot spring. From this brackish mix, a dark calcareous precipitate (c c, fig. 90) formed, which over time became more than two feet thick and contained some serpulæ. The presence of these annelids indicates that the water was salt or brackish. After this period, the temple was filled with an irregular mass of volcanic tuff (d d, fig. 90), likely from an eruption of the nearby Solfatara crater, rising between five to nine feet above the pavement. Above this, a deposit of freshwater carbonates of lime (e e, fig. 90) accumulated with an uneven bottom as it adapted to the irregular shape of the volcanic layer below it. The top of this deposit (a freshwater limestone) was completely flat, indicating an ancient water level. Mr. Babbage suggests that this freshwater lake may have formed when the fall of ash blocked the channel that previously connected to the sea, allowing the hot spring to deposit calcareous matter in the atrium without any marine mixing. Following the freshwater limestone, another irregular layer of volcanic ashes and debris (f f, fig. 90), some possibly washed in by stormy sea waves, built up to ten or eleven feet above the pavement. This takes us to the period of greatest depression shown in the accompanying diagram when the lower half of the pillars were covered by the deposits mentioned above, while the uppermost twenty feet were exposed to the air, with the middle portion, around nine feet long, being submerged in salt 515 water for years and bored through by perforating bivalves. After this period, more layers of volcanic ash and storm-washed materials further buried the pillars to heights of up to thirty-five feet above the pavement in some areas. The exact timing of when these covering layers were built up, how much occurred during submersion, and how much after the temple was raised again cannot be determined with certainty.

The period of deep submergence was certainly antecedent to the close of the fifteenth century. Professor James Forbes721 has reminded us of a passage in an old Italian writer Loffredo, who says that in 1530, or fifty years before he wrote, which was in 1580, the sea washed the base of the hills which rise from the flat land called La Starza, as represented in fig. 90, so that, to quote his words, "a person might then have fished from the site of those ruins which are now called the stadium" (A, fig. 90).

The time of deep submersion definitely happened before the end of the fifteenth century. Professor James Forbes721 pointed out a passage from an old Italian writer, Loffredo, who mentions that in 1530, or fifty years before he wrote, which was in 1580, the sea reached the base of the hills rising from the flat land known as La Starza, as shown in fig. 90. To quote him, "a person could have fished from the site of those ruins now called the stadium" (A, fig. 90).

But we know from other evidence that the upward movement had begun before 1530, for the Canonico Andrea di Jorio cites two authentic documents in illustration of this point. The first, dated Oct. 1503, is a deed written in Italian, by which Ferdinand and Isabella grant to the University of Puzzuoli a portion of land, "where the sea is drying up" (che va seccando el mare); the second, a document in Latin, dated May 23, 1511, or nearly eight years after, by which Ferdinand grants to the city a certain territory around Puzzuoli, where the ground is dried up from the sea (desiccatum).722

But we know from other evidence that the upward movement had started before 1530, as Canonico Andrea di Jorio cites two authentic documents to illustrate this point. The first, dated October 1503, is a deed written in Italian, which shows Ferdinand and Isabella granting a piece of land to the University of Puzzuoli, "where the sea is drying up" (che va seccando el mare); the second, a document in Latin, dated May 23, 1511, or nearly eight years later, where Ferdinand grants the city a certain area around Puzzuoli, where the ground is dried up from the sea (desiccatum).722

The principal elevation, however, of the low tract unquestionably took place at the time of the great eruption of Monte Nuovo in 1538. That event and the earthquakes which preceded it have been already described (p. 368); and we have seen that two of the eye-witnesses of the convulsion, Falconi and Giacomo di Toledo, agree in declaring that the sea abandoned a considerable tract of the shore, so that fish were taken by the inhabitants; and, among other things, Falconi mentions that he saw two springs in the newly discovered ruins.

The main rise of the low area definitely happened during the major eruption of Monte Nuovo in 1538. That event and the earthquakes that came before it have already been discussed (p. 368); and we've noted that two eye-witnesses of the event, Falconi and Giacomo di Toledo, both state that the sea withdrew from a large section of the shore, allowing the locals to catch fish; additionally, Falconi points out that he saw two springs in the newly discovered ruins.

The flat land, when first upraised, must have been more extensive than now, for the sea encroaches somewhat rapidly, both to the north and southeast of Puzzuoli. The coast had, when I examined it in 1828, given way more than a foot in a twelvemonth; and I was assured, by fishermen in the bay, that it has lost ground near Puzzuoli, to the extent of thirty feet, within their memory.

The flat land, when it was first raised, must have been larger than it is now, because the sea is gradually taking over, both to the north and southeast of Puzzuoli. When I checked it out in 1828, the shoreline had eroded by more than a foot in just a year; and fishermen in the bay told me that it has lost about thirty feet near Puzzuoli, during their lifetimes.

It is, moreover, very probable that the land rose to a greater height at first before it ceased to move upwards, than the level at which it was observed to stand when the temple was rediscovered in 1749, for we learn from a memoir, of Niccolini, published in 1838, that since the beginning of the nineteenth century, the temple of Serapis has subsided more than two feet. That learned architect visited the ruins frequently, for the sake of making drawings, in the beginning of the year 1807, and 516 was in the habit of remaining there throughout the day, yet never saw the pavement overflowed by the sea, except occasionally when the south wind blew violently. On his return, sixteen years after, to superintend some excavations ordered by the king of Naples, he found the pavement covered by sea-water twice every day at high tide, so that he was obliged to place there a line of stones to stand upon. This induced him to make a series of observations from Oct. 1822 to July 1838, by which means he ascertained that the ground had been and was sinking, at the average rate of about seven millimetres a year, or about one inch in four years; so that, in 1838, fish were caught every day on that part of the pavement where, in 1807, there was never a drop of water in calm weather.723

It is also quite likely that the land initially rose higher before it stopped moving upward than the level at which it was observed when the temple was rediscovered in 1749. We learn from a memoir by Niccolini, published in 1838, that since the beginning of the nineteenth century, the temple of Serapis has subsided more than two feet. That knowledgeable architect visited the ruins frequently to make drawings in early 1807 and usually stayed there all day, yet he never saw the pavement covered by the sea, except occasionally when the strong south wind blew. When he returned sixteen years later to oversee some excavations ordered by the king of Naples, he found the pavement covered by sea water twice daily at high tide, so he had to place a line of stones to stand on. This prompted him to make a series of observations from October 1822 to July 1838, through which he determined that the ground had been and was sinking at an average rate of about seven millimeters a year, or about one inch every four years; by 1838, fish were caught daily on that part of the pavement where, in 1807, there wasn't even a drop of water in calm weather.723

On inquiring still more recently as to the condition of the temple and the continuance of the sinking of the ground, I learn from Signor Scacchi in a letter, dated June 1852, that the downward movement has ceased for several years, or has at least become almost inappreciable. During an examination undertaken by him at my request in the summer of that year (1852), he observed that the rising tide spread first over the seaward side of the flat surface of the pedestals of each column (confirming the fact previously noticed by others, that they are out of the perpendicular); and he also remarked that the water gained unequally on the base of each pillar, in such a manner as to prove that they have neither the same amount of inclination, nor lean precisely in the same direction.

On further inquiring about the condition of the temple and whether the ground was still sinking, I learned from Signor Scacchi in a letter dated June 1852 that the downward movement has stopped for several years or has at least become barely noticeable. During an examination he conducted at my request in the summer of that year (1852), he observed that the rising tide first spread over the seaward side of the flat surface of each column's pedestal (confirming a previous observation by others that they are not perfectly vertical); he also noted that the water was unevenly gaining at the base of each pillar, indicating that they do not have the same angle of inclination and do not lean in exactly the same direction.

From what was said before (p. 510), we saw that the marine shells in the strata forming the plain called La Starza, considered separately, establish the fact of an upheaval of the ground to the height of twenty-three feet and upwards. The temple proves much more, because it could not have been built originally under water, and must therefore first have sunk down twenty feet at least below the waves, to be afterwards restored to its original position. Yet if such was the order of events we ought to meet with other independent signs of a like subsidence round the margin of a bay once so studded with buildings as the Bay of Baiæ. Accordingly memorials of such submergence are not wanting. About a mile northwest of the temple of Serapis, and about 500 feet from the shore, are the ruins of a temple of Neptune and others of a temple of the Nymphs, now underwater. The columns of the former edifice stand erect in five feet of water, their upper portions just rising to the surface of the sea. The pedestals are doubtless buried in the sand or mud; so that, if this part of the bottom of the bay should hereafter be elevated, the exhumation of these temples might take place after the manner of that of Serapis. Both these buildings probably participated in the movement which raised the Starza; but either they were deeper under water than the temple of Serapis, or they were not raised 517 up again to so great a height. There are also two Roman roads under water in the bay, one reaching from Puzzuoli to the Lucrine Lake, which may still be seen, and the other near the castle of Baiæ (No. 8, fig. 88, p. 509). The ancient mole, too, of Puzzuoli (No. 4, ibid.) before alluded to, has the water up to a considerable height of the arches; whereas Brieslak justly observes, it is next to certain that the piers must formerly have reached the surface before the springing of the arches;724 so that, although the phenomena before described prove that this mole has been uplifted ten feet above the level at which it once stood, it is still evident that it has not yet been restored to its original position.

From what we discussed earlier (p. 510), we observed that the marine shells in the layers making up the plain known as La Starza confirm that the ground has risen by at least twenty-three feet. The temple provides even stronger evidence since it couldn't have been built underwater and must have first dropped at least twenty feet below the waves before being raised back to its original height. If this sequence of events is accurate, we should find other independent signs of similar sinking around the edges of a bay that was once filled with buildings like the Bay of Baiæ. Indeed, there are indications of such submergence. About a mile northwest of the temple of Serapis, and roughly 500 feet from the shore, lie the ruins of a temple dedicated to Neptune and another temple for the Nymphs, both now submerged. The columns of the first temple stand upright in five feet of water, with their tops just reaching the sea's surface. The pedestals are likely buried in sand or mud, so if this part of the bay's bottom is raised in the future, these temples might be uncovered similarly to the temple of Serapis. Both structures probably experienced the same uplift that affected La Starza, but either they were deeper underwater than the temple of Serapis or were not raised to such a height. There are also two Roman roads submerged in the bay, one connecting Puzzuoli to Lucrine Lake, which can still be seen, and the other near the castle of Baiæ (No. 8, fig. 88, p. 509). The ancient mole of Puzzuoli (No. 4, ibid.) mentioned earlier has water reaching a significant height against the arches; however, as Brieslak rightly points out, it is almost certain that the piers must have originally extended to the surface before the arches were built;724 so while the phenomena described earlier indicate that this mole has been lifted ten feet above its original level, it is clear that it has not yet been returned to its former position.

A modern writer also reminds us, that these effects are not so local as some would have us to believe; for on the opposite side of the Bay of Naples, on the Sorrentine coast, which, as well as Puzzuoli, is subject to earthquakes, a road, with some fragments of Roman buildings, is covered to some depth by the sea. In the island of Capri, also, which is situated some way out at sea, in the opening of the Bay of Naples, one of the palaces of Tiberius is now covered with water.725

A modern writer also reminds us that these effects are not as localized as some might think. On the opposite side of the Bay of Naples, on the Sorrentine coast, which, like Puzzuoli, experiences earthquakes, a road with some remnants of Roman buildings is partially submerged under the sea. In the island of Capri, which is situated further out in the water at the entrance of the Bay of Naples, one of Tiberius's palaces is now underwater.725

That buildings should have been submerged, and afterwards upheaved, without being entirely reduced to a heap of ruins, will appear no anomaly, when we recollect that, in the year 1819, when the delta of the Indus sank down, the houses within the fort of Sindree subsided beneath the waves without being overthrown. In like manner, in the year 1692, the buildings round the harbor of Port Royal, in Jamaica, descended suddenly to the depth of between thirty and fifty feet under the sea without falling. Even on small portions of land transported to a distance of a mile down a declivity, tenements, like those near Mileto, in Calabria, were carried entire. At Valparaiso buildings were left standing in 1822, when their foundations, together with a long tract of the Chilian coast, were permanently upraised to the height of several feet. It is still more easy to conceive that an edifice may escape falling during the upheaval or subsidence of land, if the walls are supported on the exterior and interior with a deposit like that which surrounded and filled to the height of ten or eleven feet the temple of Serapis all the time it was sinking, and which enveloped it to more than twice that height when it was rising again to its original level.

That buildings could be submerged and then lifted back up without being completely destroyed isn’t surprising when we remember that in 1819, when the delta of the Indus sank, the houses in the fort of Sindree went underwater but weren’t knocked down. Similarly, in 1692, the structures around the harbor of Port Royal in Jamaica suddenly dropped to a depth of thirty to fifty feet underwater without collapsing. Even on small pieces of land that moved a mile down a slope, homes like those near Mileto in Calabria were carried away intact. In Valparaiso in 1822, buildings remained standing even when their foundations, along with a long stretch of the Chilean coast, were uplifted several feet. It's even easier to understand how a building might stay upright during the raising or lowering of land if its walls are supported both inside and outside by something like the material that surrounded and filled the temple of Serapis to a height of ten or eleven feet while it was sinking, and which covered it to more than twice that height when it was rising back to its original level.

We can scarcely avoid the conclusion, as Mr. Babbage has hinted, "that the action of heat is in some way or other the cause of the phenomena of the change of level of the temple. Its own hot spring, its immediate contiguity to the Solfatara, its nearness to the Monte Nuovo, the hot spring at the baths of Nero (No. 6, fig. 88), on the opposite side of the Bay of Baiæ; the boiling springs and ancient volcanoes of Ischia on one side and Vesuvius on the other, are the most prominent 518 of a multitude of facts which point to that conclusion."726 And when we reflect on the dates of the principal oscillations of level, and the volcanic history of the country before described (chap. 23), we seem to discover a connection between each era of upheaval and a local development of volcanic heat, and again between each era of depression and the local quiescence or dormant condition of the subterranean igneous causes. Thus for example, before the Christian era, when so many vents were in frequent eruption in Ischia, and when Avernus and other points in the Phlegræan Fields were celebrated for their volcanic aspect and character, the ground on which the temple stood was several feet above water. Vesuvius was then regarded as a spent volcano; but when, after the Christian era, the fires of that mountain were rekindled, scarcely a single outburst was ever witnessed in Ischia, or around the Bay of Baiæ. Then the temple was sinking. Vesuvius, at a subsequent period, became nearly dormant for five centuries preceding the great outbreak of 1631 (see p. 374), and in that interval the Solfatara was in eruption A. D. 1198, Ischia in 1302, and Monte Nuovo was formed in 1538. Then the foundations on which the temple stood were rising again. Lastly, Vesuvius once more became a most active vent, and has been so ever since, and during the same lapse of time the area of the temple, so far as we know any thing of its history, has been subsiding.

We can hardly avoid the conclusion, as Mr. Babbage has suggested, "that heat somehow causes the changes in the temple's water level. Its own hot spring, its close proximity to the Solfatara, its nearness to Monte Nuovo, and the hot spring at Nero's baths (No. 6, fig. 88), on the opposite side of the Bay of Baiæ; the boiling springs and ancient volcanoes of Ischia on one side and Vesuvius on the other, are the most significant of many facts that point to this conclusion." 518 And when we consider the dates of the major level changes and the volcanic history of the area described earlier (chap. 23), we seem to see a link between each period of uplift and a local increase in volcanic activity, and again between each period of decline and the local quiet or dormant state of the underground volcanic forces. For example, before the Christian era, when many vents were frequently erupting in Ischia and when Avernus and other places in the Phlegræan Fields were known for their volcanic appearance, the ground under the temple was several feet above water. Vesuvius was then thought to be a dead volcano; but when, after the Christian era, the fires of that mountain were reignited, few eruptions were ever recorded in Ischia or around the Bay of Baiæ. At that point, the temple was sinking. Later, Vesuvius became largely inactive for five centuries before the major eruption of 1631 (see p. 374), and during that time the Solfatara erupted in A. D. 1198, Ischia in 1302, and Monte Nuovo formed in 1538. At that time, the ground under the temple was rising again. Finally, Vesuvius became an active volcano once more, and it has remained so ever since, while during the same period the area around the temple, as far as we know about its history, has been sinking.

These phenomena would agree well with the hypothesis, that when the subterranean heat is on the increase, and when lava is forming without obtaining an easy vent, like that afforded by a great habitual chimney, such as Vesuvius, the incumbent surface is uplifted; but when the heated rocks below are cooling and contracting, and sheets of lava are slowly consolidating and diminishing in volume, then the incumbent land subsides.

These phenomena align well with the hypothesis that when underground heat rises and lava forms without an easy outlet, like the one provided by a large, regular vent such as Vesuvius, the surface above is pushed upward. However, when the heated rocks below cool and contract, and layers of lava slowly solidify and decrease in volume, then the land above sinks.

Signor Niccolini, when he ascertained in 1838 that the relative levels of the floor of the temple and of the sea were slowly changing from year to year, embraced the opinion that it was the sea which was rising. But Signor Capocci successfully controverted this view, appealing to many appearances which attest the local character of the movements of the adjoining country, besides the historical fact that in 1538, when the sea retired permanently 200 yards from the ancient shore at Puzzuoli, there was no simultaneous retreat of the waters from Naples, Castelamare, and Ischia.727

Signor Niccolini, upon realizing in 1838 that the height of the temple floor and the sea was gradually shifting each year, believed that the sea was rising. However, Signor Capocci effectively challenged this idea, citing various observations that indicate the local nature of the movements in the surrounding area, as well as the historical fact that in 1538, when the sea permanently withdrew 200 yards from the ancient shore at Puzzuoli, there was no corresponding retreat of the waters from Naples, Castelamare, and Ischia.727

Permanence of the ocean's level.—In concluding this subject I may observe, that the interminable controversies to which the phenomena of the Bay of Baiæ gave rise, have sprung from an extreme reluctance to admit that the land, rather than the sea, is subject alternately to rise and fall. Had it been assumed that the level of the ocean was invariable, on the ground that no fluctuations have as yet been clearly established, and that, on the other hand, the continents are inconstant in 519 their level, as has been demonstrated by the most unequivocal proofs again and again, from the time of Strabo to our own times, the appearances of the temple at Puzzuoli could never have been regarded as enigmatical. Even if contemporary accounts had not distinctly attested the upraising of the coast, this explanation should have been proposed in the first instance as the most natural, instead of being now adopted unwillingly when all others have failed.

Permanence of the ocean's level.—To wrap up this topic, I’d like to point out that the endless debates sparked by the phenomena of the Bay of Baiæ come from a deep unwillingness to accept that the land, rather than the sea, goes through cycles of rising and falling. If it had been accepted that the ocean level is constant, because no significant changes have been clearly observed so far, while, on the other hand, the continents are unstable in their level, as has been shown by clear evidence repeatedly from Strabo's time to today, the sights of the temple at Puzzuoli would never have seemed puzzling. Even if contemporary accounts hadn’t clearly confirmed the raising of the coast, this explanation should have been suggested initially as the most logical, instead of being reluctantly accepted now after all other options have failed.

To the strong prejudices still existing in regard to the mobility of the land, we may attribute the rarity of such discoveries as have been recently brought to light in the Bay of Baiæ and the Bay of Conception. A false theory, it is well known, may render us blind to facts which are opposed to our prepossessions, or may conceal from us their true import when we behold them. But it is time that the geologist should, in some degree, overcome those first and natural impressions, which induced the poets of old to select the rock as the emblem of firmness—the sea as the image of inconstancy. Our modern poet, in a more philosophical spirit, saw in the sea "The image of eternity," and has finely contrasted the fleeting existence of the successive empires which have flourished and fallen on the borders of the ocean with its own unchanged stability.

To the strong biases still present regarding the movement of the land, we can attribute the rarity of discoveries recently uncovered in the Bay of Baiæ and the Bay of Conception. A false theory, as is well-known, can blind us to facts that contradict our assumptions or can obscure their true meaning when we encounter them. But it’s time for geologists to, to some extent, move past those initial and natural impressions that led ancient poets to choose rock as the symbol of stability and the sea as the representation of unpredictability. Our modern poet, with a more philosophical mindset, viewed the sea as "The image of eternity," and beautifully contrasted the fleeting nature of successive empires that have thrived and fallen along the ocean's edge with its own unchanging permanence.

Their decline Has turned dry lands into deserts:—not you, Unchangeable, except for the wild waves' movement: Time leaves no marks on your blue brow; Just as creation's dawn witnessed, you are now rolling. Childe Harold, Canto 4.

CHAPTER XXX.

ELEVATION AND SUBSIDENCE OF LAND WITHOUT EARTHQUAKES.

Changes in the relative level of land and sea in regions not volcanic—Opinion of Celsius that the waters of the Baltic Sea and Northern Ocean were sinking—Objections raised to his opinion—Proofs of the stability of the sea level in the Baltic—Playfair's hypothesis that the land was rising in Sweden—Opinion of Von Buch—Marks cut on the rocks—Survey of these in 1820—Facility of detecting slight alterations of level on coast of Sweden—Shores of the ocean also rising—Area upheaved—Shelly deposits of Uddevalla—Of Stockholm, containing fossil shells characteristic of the Baltic—Subsidence in south of Sweden—Fishing hut buried under marine strata—Upheaval in Sweden not always in horizontal planes—Sinking of land in Greenland—Bearing of these facts on geology.

Changes in the relative levels of land and sea in non-volcanic areas—Celsius's belief that the waters of the Baltic Sea and Northern Ocean were sinking—Challenges to his belief—Evidence of the stability of the sea level in the Baltic—Playfair's theory that the land was rising in Sweden—Von Buch's perspective—Marks cut into the rocks—Survey of these in 1820—Easy detection of slight changes in level along the coast of Sweden—Ocean shores also rising—Uplifted area—Shell deposits in Uddevalla—In Stockholm, containing fossil shells typical of the Baltic—Subsidence in southern Sweden—Fishing hut buried under marine layers—Uplift in Sweden not always occurring in horizontal planes—Sinking of land in Greenland—Implications of these facts for geology.

We have now considered the phenomena of volcanoes and earthquakes according to the division of the subject before proposed (p. 345), and have next to turn our attention to those slow and insensible changes in the relative level of land and sea which take place in countries remote from volcanoes, and where no violent earthquakes have occurred within the period of human observation. Early in the last century the Swedish 520 naturalist, Celsius, expressed his opinion that the waters, both of the Baltic and Northern Ocean, were gradually subsiding. From numerous observations, he inferred that the rate of depression was about fifty Swedish inches in a century.728 In support of this position, he alleged that there were many rocks both on the shores of the Baltic and the ocean known to have been once sunken reefs, and dangerous to navigators, but which were in his time above water—that the waters of the Gulf of Bothnia had been gradually converted into land, several ancient ports having been changed into inland cities, small islands joined to the continent, and old fishing-grounds deserted as being too shallow, or entirely dried up. Celsius also maintained, that the evidence of the change rested not only on modern observations, but on the authority of the ancient geographers, who had stated that Scandinavia was formerly an island. This island, he argued, must in the course of centuries, by the gradual retreat of the sea, have become connected with the continent; an event which he supposed to have happened after the time of Pliny, and before the ninth century of our era.

We have now looked at the phenomena of volcanoes and earthquakes as outlined earlier (p. 345) and will next focus on the slow and subtle changes in the relative levels of land and sea that occur in areas far from volcanoes and where no major earthquakes have happened within recorded history. Early in the last century, the Swedish naturalist Celsius shared his belief that the waters of both the Baltic and the Northern Ocean were gradually sinking. Through various observations, he concluded that the rate of this sinking was about fifty Swedish inches per century.728 To support his view, he pointed out many rocks along the shores of the Baltic and the ocean that were once underwater reefs and hazardous for sailors, but were above water in his time. He noted that the waters of the Gulf of Bothnia had slowly become land, with several ancient ports transforming into inland cities, small islands merging with the mainland, and old fishing areas abandoned as they became too shallow or completely dried up. Celsius also argued that the evidence for this change was based not just on recent observations but also on accounts from ancient geographers, who claimed that Scandinavia was once an island. He argued that this island must have gradually connected with the continent over centuries due to the sea receding, an event he believed occurred after the time of Pliny and before the ninth century of our era.

To this argument it was objected that the ancients were so ignorant of the geography of the most northern parts of Europe, that their authority was entitled to no weight; and that their representation of Scandinavia as an island, might with more propriety be adduced to prove the scantiness of their information, than to confirm so bold an hypothesis. It was also remarked that if the land which connected Scandinavia with the main continent was laid dry between the time of Pliny and the ninth century, to the extent to which it is known to have risen above the sea at the latter period, the rate of depression could not have been uniform, as was pretended; for it ought to have fallen much more rapidly between the ninth and eighteenth centuries.

It was argued that the ancients knew so little about the geography of the northern parts of Europe that their opinions weren't credible. Their depiction of Scandinavia as an island could better illustrate their lack of knowledge rather than support such a daring theory. It was also noted that if the land connecting Scandinavia to the main continent was exposed between Pliny's time and the ninth century, to the degree that it's known to have been above sea level by the latter period, the rate of subsidence couldn't have been consistent as suggested. It should have decreased much more quickly between the ninth and eighteenth centuries.

Many of the proofs relied on by Celsius and his followers were immediately controverted by several philosophers, who saw clearly that a fall of the sea in any one region could not take place without a general sinking of the waters over the whole globe: they denied that this was the fact, or that the depression was universal, even in the Baltic. In proof of the stability of the level of that sea, they appealed to the position of the island of Saltholm, not far from Copenhagen. This island is so low, that in autumn and winter it is permanently overflowed; and it is only dry in summer, when it serves for pasturing cattle. It appears, from the documents of the year 1280, that Saltholm was then also in the same state, and exactly on a level with the mean height of the sea, instead of having been about twenty feet under water, as it ought to have been, according to the computation of Celsius. Several towns, also, on the shores of the Baltic, as Lubeck, Wismar, Rostock, Stralsund, and others, after six and even eight hundred years, are as little elevated above the sea as at the era of their foundation, being now close to the water's edge. The lowest part of Dantzic was no higher than the mean 521 level of the sea in the year 1000; and after eight centuries its relative position remains exactly the same.729

Many of the arguments used by Celsius and his followers were quickly challenged by several philosophers, who clearly understood that a drop in sea levels in any one area couldn't happen without a global drop in water levels. They disputed that this was true or that the depression was widespread, even in the Baltic Sea. To prove that the level of that sea was stable, they pointed to the island of Saltholm, not far from Copenhagen. This island is so low that it is permanently flooded in autumn and winter; it's only dry in summer when it’s used for grazing cattle. Records from 1280 show that Saltholm was in the same condition then, at exactly the same level as the average height of the sea, instead of being about twenty feet underwater, as Celsius calculated it should have been. Several towns along the Baltic, like Lubeck, Wismar, Rostock, Stralsund, and others, are still as close to sea level now as they were when they were founded, remaining right at the water's edge even after six or eight hundred years. The lowest part of Dantzic was no higher than the average sea level in the year 1000, and after eight centuries, its position relative to the sea is still exactly the same.521

Several of the examples of the gain of land and shallowing of the sea pointed out by Celsius, and afterwards by Linnæus, who embraced the same opinions, were ascribed by others to the deposition of sediment at points where rivers entered; and, undoubtedly, Celsius had not sufficiently distinguished between changes due to these causes and such as would arise if the waters of the ocean itself were diminishing. Many large rivers descending from a mountainous country, at the head of the Gulf of Bothnia, enter the sea charged with sand, mud, and pebbles; and it was said that in these places the low land had advanced rapidly, especially near Torneo. At Piteo also, half a mile had been gained in forty-five years; at Luleo,730 no less than a mile in twenty-eight years; facts which might all be admitted consistently with the assumption that the level of the Baltic has remained unchanged, like that of the Adriatic, during a period when the plains of the Po and the Adige have greatly extended their area.

Several examples of land gaining and the seas becoming shallower noted by Celsius, and later by Linnæus, who shared the same views, were attributed by others to sediment deposition where rivers meet the sea. Celsius clearly hadn't fully differentiated between changes caused by this and those that would occur if the ocean itself were receding. Many large rivers flowing from mountainous regions at the northern edge of the Gulf of Bothnia enter the sea carrying sand, mud, and pebbles. It was reported that in these areas, low land had expanded quickly, especially near Torneo. At Piteo, half a mile had been gained in forty-five years; at Luleo,730 even a mile in twenty-eight years; facts which could all be accepted while assuming that the level of the Baltic has stayed the same, similar to the Adriatic, during a time when the plains of the Po and the Adige have significantly increased in size.

It was also alleged that certain insular rocks, once entirely covered with water, had at length protruded themselves above the waves, and grown, in the course of a century and a half, to be eight feet high. The following attempt was made to explain away this phenomenon:—In the Baltic, large erratic blocks, as well as sand and smaller stones which lie on shoals, are liable every year to be frozen into the ice, where the sea freezes to the depth of five or six feet. On the melting of the snow in spring, when the sea rises about half a fathom, numerous ice-islands float away, bearing up these rocky fragments so as to convey them to a distance; and if they are driven by the waves upon shoals, they may convert them into islands by depositing the blocks; if stranded upon low islands, they may considerably augment their height.

It was also claimed that some isolated rocks, which were completely underwater at first, eventually rose above the waves and grew to eight feet tall over a period of a century and a half. Here’s one explanation for this phenomenon: In the Baltic, large random boulders, along with sand and smaller stones that sit on shoals, often get frozen into the ice each year when the sea freezes to a depth of five or six feet. When the snow melts in the spring and the sea level rises by about half a fathom, many ice islands break free, carrying these rocky fragments away. If these fragments are pushed by the waves onto shoals, they can create islands by dropping off the boulders; if they end up on low islands, they can significantly increase their height.

Browallius, also, and some other Swedish naturalists, affirmed that some islands were lower than formerly; and that, by reference to this kind of evidence, there was equally good reason for contending that the level of the Baltic was gradually rising. They also added another curious proof of the permanency of the water level, at some points at least, for many centuries. On the Finland coast were some large pines, growing close to the water's edge; these were cut down, and, by counting the concentric rings of annual growth, as seen in a transverse section of the trunk, it was demonstrated that they had stood there for four hundred years. Now, according to the Celsian hypothesis, the sea had sunk about fifteen feet during that period, in which case the germination and early growth of these pines must have been, for many seasons, below the level of the water. In like manner it was asserted, that the lower walls of many ancient castles, such as those of Sonderburg 522 and Åbo, reached then to the water's edge, and must, therefore, according to the theory of Celsius, have been originally constructed below the level of the sea.

Browallius and some other Swedish naturalists claimed that some islands were lower than they used to be, and that there was just as much reason to argue that the level of the Baltic Sea was gradually rising based on this kind of evidence. They also provided another interesting piece of evidence supporting the stability of the water level, at least at certain points, for many centuries. On the Finland coast, there were large pines growing right by the water's edge; these trees were cut down, and by counting the concentric rings of annual growth visible in a cross-section of the trunk, it was shown that they had been there for four hundred years. According to the Celsian hypothesis, the sea had dropped about fifteen feet during that time, which means that the germination and early growth of these pines must have occurred for many years below the water level. Similarly, it was claimed that the lower walls of many ancient castles, like those in Sonderburg and Åbo, reached the water's edge at that time and, according to Celsius's theory, must have originally been built below sea level.

Fig. 91.Map of Scandinavia.

In reply to this last argument, Colonel Hällstrom, a Swedish engineer, well acquainted with the Finland coast, assured me, that the base of the walls of the castle of Åbo is now ten feet above the water, so 523 that there may have been a considerable rise of the land at that point since the building was erected.

In response to this last point, Colonel Hällstrom, a Swedish engineer familiar with the Finnish coast, assured me that the base of the walls of Åbo Castle is now ten feet above the water, so 523 there may have been a significant rise in the land at that location since the castle was built.

Playfair, in his "Illustrations of the Huttonian Theory," in 1802, admitted the sufficiency of the proofs adduced by Celsius, but attributed the change of level to the movement of the land, rather than to a diminution of the waters. He observed, "that in order to depress or elevate the absolute level of the sea, by a given quantity, in any one place, we must depress or elevate it by the same quantity over the whole surface of the earth; whereas no such necessity exists with respect to the elevation or depression of the land."731 The hypothesis of the rising of the land he adds, "agrees well with the Huttonian theory, which holds, that our continents are subject to be acted upon by the expansive forces of the mineral regions; that by these forces they have been actually raised up, and are sustained by them in their present situation.732

Playfair, in his "Illustrations of the Huttonian Theory," in 1802, accepted the evidence presented by Celsius but attributed the change in sea level to the movement of the land instead of a decrease in water levels. He noted, "to raise or lower the absolute level of the sea by a specific amount in any location, we must raise or lower it by the same amount across the entire surface of the Earth; however, this is not necessary for the elevation or depression of the land."731 He added that the idea of land rising "fits well with the Huttonian theory, which states that our continents are influenced by the expansive forces of the mineral regions; that these forces have actually lifted them up and continue to support them in their current position."732

In the year 1807, Von Buch, after returning from a tour in Scandinavia, announced his conviction, "that the whole country, from Frederickshall in Norway to Åbo in Finland, and perhaps as far as St. Petersburg, was slowly and insensibly rising." He also suggested "that Sweden may rise more than Norway, and the northern more than the southern part."733 He was led to these conclusions principally by information obtained from the inhabitants and pilots, and in part by the occurrence of marine shells of recent species, which he had found at several points on the coast of Norway above the level of the sea. He also mentions the marks set on the rocks. Von Buch, therefore, has the merit of being the first geologist who, after a personal examination of the evidence, declared in favor of the rise of land in Scandinavia.

In 1807, Von Buch, after returning from a trip to Scandinavia, expressed his belief that "the entire region, from Frederickshall in Norway to Åbo in Finland, and possibly as far as St. Petersburg, is gradually and imperceptibly rising." He also noted that "Sweden might be rising more than Norway, and the northern parts more than the southern." 733 He reached these conclusions mainly based on information gathered from local residents and pilots, as well as the discovery of marine shells of recent species at various locations on the coast of Norway above sea level. He also referenced markings on the rocks. Therefore, Von Buch deserves credit for being the first geologist to publicly support the idea of land rising in Scandinavia after personally examining the evidence.

The attention excited by this subject in the early part of the last century, induced many philosophers in Sweden to endeavor to determine, by accurate observations, whether the standard level of the Baltic was really subject to periodical variations; and under their direction, lines or grooves, indicating the ordinary level of the water on a calm day, together with the date of the year, were chiselled out upon the rocks. In 1820-21, all the marks made before those years were examined by the officers of the pilotage establishment of Sweden; and in their report to the Royal Academy of Stockholm they declared, that on comparing the level of the sea at the time of their observations with that indicated by the ancient marks, they found that the Baltic was lower relatively to the land in certain places, but the amount of change during equal periods of time had not been everywhere the same. During their survey, they cut new marks for the guidance of future observers, several of which I had an opportunity of examining fourteen years after (in the summer of 1834), and in that interval the land appeared to me to have risen at certain places north of Stockholm four or five inches. I also convinced myself, during my visit to Sweden, after conversing with many civil engineers, pilots, and fishermen, and 524 after examining some of the ancient marks, that the evidence formerly adduced in favor of the change of level, both on the coasts of Sweden and Finland, was full and satisfactory.734 The alteration of level evidently diminishes as we proceed from the northern parts of the Gulf of Bothnia towards the south, being very slight around Stockholm. Some writers have indeed represented the rate of depression of the waters at Stockholm as very considerable, because certain houses in that city which are built on piles have sunk down within the memory of persons still living, so as to be out of the perpendicular; and this in consequence of the tops of the piles giving way and decaying, owing to a fall of the waters which has exposed them to be alternately wet and dry. The houses alluded to are situated on the borders of Lake Maeler, a large lake, the outlet of which joins the Baltic, in the middle of Stockholm. This lake is certainly lower than formerly; but the principal cause of the change is not the elevation of the land, but the removal of two old bridges built on piles, which formerly obstructed the discharge of the fresh water into the sea. Another cause is the opening, in the year 1819, of a new canal at Södertelje, a place south of Stockholm, by means of which a new line of communication was formed between Lake Maeler and the Baltic.735

The interest sparked by this topic in the early part of the last century led many philosophers in Sweden to try and determine, through careful observations, whether the standard level of the Baltic Sea actually experienced periodic changes. Under their guidance, lines or grooves were carved into the rocks, showing the usual water level on a calm day, along with the date of the year. In 1820-21, the officers from Sweden's pilotage establishment examined all the marks made prior to those years. In their report to the Royal Academy of Stockholm, they stated that, when comparing the sea level during their observations with what the old marks indicated, they found that the Baltic was lower in certain locations relative to the land, although the amount of change over equal time periods was not the same everywhere. During their survey, they created new marks for future observers, several of which I had the chance to examine fourteen years later (in the summer of 1834), and in that time frame, it appeared to me that the land had risen about four or five inches in certain areas north of Stockholm. I also confirmed, during my visit to Sweden and after talking to various civil engineers, pilots, and fishermen, as well as examining some of the old marks, that the evidence previously presented regarding the level change along the coasts of Sweden and Finland was comprehensive and convincing. The change in level clearly decreases as we move from the northern regions of the Gulf of Bothnia southward, being very slight around Stockholm. Some writers have indeed portrayed the rate of water depression in Stockholm as quite significant, since certain buildings in the city, which are built on piles, have sunk over the lifetime of living individuals, causing them to lean. This is due to the tops of the piles giving way and deteriorating, owing to a drop in water levels that has exposed them to alternating wet and dry conditions. The houses mentioned are located on the edges of Lake Mälaren, a large lake that flows into the Baltic in the center of Stockholm. This lake is certainly at a lower level than it used to be; however, the main reason for the change is not the land's elevation, but the removal of two old bridges built on piles that previously hindered the fresh water from properly draining into the sea. Another factor is the opening of a new canal in 1819 at Södertälje, south of Stockholm, which created a new route connecting Lake Mälaren and the Baltic.

It will naturally be asked, whether the mean level of a sea like the Baltic can ever be determined so exactly as to permit us to appreciate a variation of level, amounting only to one or two feet. In reply, I may observe, that, except near the Cattegat, there are no tides in the Baltic; and it is only when particular winds have prevailed for several days in succession, or at certain seasons when there has been an unusually abundant influx of river water, or when these causes have combined, that this sea is made to rise two or three feet above its standard level. The fluctuations due to these causes are nearly the same from year to year; so that the pilots and fishermen believe and apparently with reason, that they can mark a deviation, even of a few inches, from the ordinary or mean height of the waters.

It will be asked if the average level of a sea like the Baltic can be determined accurately enough to notice a change in level of just one or two feet. In response, I would point out that, except near the Cattegat, there are no tides in the Baltic; and it is only when certain winds blow for several days in a row, or during specific seasons with a significant influx of river water, or when these factors combine, that the sea rises two or three feet above its normal level. The changes caused by these factors are pretty consistent from year to year, so pilots and fishermen believe, and seem to be justified in believing, that they can detect even a minor deviation of a few inches from the typical or average height of the water.

There are, moreover, peculiarities in the configuration of the shores of Norway and Sweden, which facilitate in a remarkable degree the appreciation of slight changes in the relative level of land and water. It has often been said, that there are two coasts, an inner and an outer one; the inner being the shore of the main land; the outer one, a fringe of countless rocky islands of all dimensions, called the skär (shair). Boats and small vessels make their coasting voyages within this skär: for here they may sail in smooth water, even when the sea without is strongly agitated. But the navigation is very intricate, 525 and the pilot must possess a perfect acquaintance with the breadth and depth of every narrow channel, and the position of innumerable sunken rocks. If on such a coast the land rises one or two feet in the course of half a century, the minute topography of the skär is entirely altered. To a stranger, indeed, who revisits it after an interval of many years, its general aspect remains the same; but the inhabitant finds that he can no longer penetrate with his boat through channels where he formerly passed, and he can tell of countless other changes in the height and breadth of isolated rocks, now exposed, but once only seen through the clear water.

There are also unique features in the coastlines of Norway and Sweden that greatly enhance the ability to notice small changes in the relative levels of land and water. It's often said that there are two coasts: an inner one that borders the mainland and an outer one made up of countless rocky islands of various sizes, known as the skär (shair). Boats and small vessels travel along the inner coast of this skär, where they can sail in calm waters even when the open sea is rough. However, navigation is quite complicated, and the pilot needs to have a thorough understanding of the width and depth of every narrow channel and the location of countless submerged rocks. If, along such a coast, the land rises by one or two feet over the course of fifty years, the detailed topography of the skär is completely changed. To an outsider who returns after many years, the overall look of the place may seem the same, but the local resident discovers that they can no longer navigate through channels they once used and can recount numerous other changes in the height and size of isolated rocks that are now visible but were previously only seen through clear water.

The rocks of gneiss, mica-schist, and quartz are usually very hard on this coast, slow to decompose, and, when protected from the breakers, remaining for ages unaltered in their form. Hence it is easy to mark the stages of their progressive emergence by the aid of natural and artificial marks imprinted on them. Besides the summits of fixed rocks, there are numerous erratic blocks of vast size strewed over the shoals and islands in the skär, which have been probably drifted by ice in the manner before suggested.736 All these are observed to have increased in height and dimension with the last half century. Some, which were formerly known as dangerous sunken rocks, are now only hidden when the water is highest. On their first appearance, they usually present a smooth, bare, rounded protuberance, a few feet or yards in diameter; and a single sea-gull often appropriates to itself this resting-place, resorting there to devour its prey. Similar points, in the mean time, have grown to long reefs, and are constantly whitened by a multitude of sea-fowl; while others have been changed from a reef, annually submerged, to a small islet, on which a few lichens, a fir-seedling, and a few blades of grass, attest that the shoal has at length been fairly changed into dry land. Thousands of wooded islands around show the great alterations which time can work. In the course of centuries also, the spaces intervening between the existing islands may be laid dry, and become grassy plains encircled by heights well clothed with lofty firs. This last step of the process, by which long fiords and narrow channels, once separating wooded islands, are deserted by the sea, has been exemplified within the memory of living witnesses on several parts of the coast.

The rocks of gneiss, mica-schist, and quartz along this coast are generally very hard, slow to break down, and, when shielded from the waves, can remain unchanged for centuries. So, it’s easy to see how they’ve gradually emerged over time, thanks to natural and man-made marks left on them. In addition to the peaks of stable rocks, there are many large erratic boulders scattered over the shallows and islands in the skär, likely moved by ice as previously suggested.736 All of these have been seen to rise in height and size over the last fifty years. Some rocks that were once considered dangerous underwater are now only submerged during high water. At first, they typically appear as smooth, rounded bumps a few feet or yards across; a single sea gull often claims one of these spots as a resting place to eat its catch. Meanwhile, similar points have transformed into long reefs, constantly covered in a multitude of seabirds; others have changed from regularly submerged reefs into small islands, where a few lichens, a fir seedling, and some blades of grass show that the shallow area has finally turned into dry land. Thousands of wooded islands around demonstrate the significant changes that time can bring. Over centuries, the spaces between the existing islands can also become dry and turn into grassy plains surrounded by heights populated with tall fir trees. This final stage, where long fjords and narrow channels that once separated wooded islands are abandoned by the sea, has been witnessed within the memories of people living today in several parts of the coast.

Had the apparent fall of the waters been observed in the Baltic only, we might have endeavored to explain the phenomenon by local causes affecting that sea alone. For instance, the channel by which the Baltic discharges its surplus waters into the Atlantic, might be supposed to have been gradually widened and deepened by the waves and currents, in which case a fall of the water like that before alluded to in Lake Maeler, might have occurred. But the lowering of level would in that case have been uniform and universal, and the waters could not have sunk at Torneo, while they retained their former level at Copenhagen. Such an explanation is also untenable on other grounds; for it is a fact, 526 as Celsius long ago affirmed, that the alteration of level extends to the western shores of Sweden, bordering the ocean. The signs of elevation observed between Uddevalla and Gothenburg are as well established as those on the shores of the Bothnian Gulf. Among the places where they may be studied, are the islands of Marstrand and Gulholmen, the last-mentioned locality being one of those particularly pointed out by Celsius.

Had the noticeable drop in water levels been seen only in the Baltic, we might have tried to explain it with local factors affecting just that sea. For example, one might think the channel that allows the Baltic to drain into the Atlantic was gradually widened and deepened by the waves and currents, which could have caused a drop in water levels similar to what was mentioned earlier about Lake Maeler. However, in that case, the drop in levels would have been consistent and universal, meaning the waters couldn't have dropped in Torneo while staying the same in Copenhagen. This explanation is also flawed for other reasons; it is a fact, 526 as Celsius noted long ago, that the change in water levels also affects the western shores of Sweden, which border the ocean. The signs of rising land observed between Uddevalla and Gothenburg are just as well documented as those along the shores of the Bothnian Gulf. Among the locations where they can be examined are the islands of Marstrand and Gulholmen, with the latter being specifically highlighted by Celsius.

The inhabitants there and elsewhere affirm, that the rate of the sinking of the sea (or elevation of land) varies in different and adjoining districts, being greatest at points where the land is low. But in this they are deceived; for they measure the amount of rise by the area gained, which is most considerable where the land descends with a gentle slope into the sea. In the same manner, some advocates of the Celsian theory formerly appealed to the increase of lands near the mouths of rivers, not sufficiently adverting to the fact, that if the bed of the sea is rising, the change will always be most sensible where the bottom has been previously rendered shallow; whereas, at a distance from these points where the scarped granitic cliffs plunge at once into deep water, a much greater amount of elevation is necessary to produce an equally conspicuous change.

The people there and in other places believe that the rate at which the sea is sinking (or land is rising) varies in different neighboring areas, being highest where the land is low. But they are mistaken; they gauge the amount of rise by the area gained, which is most noticeable where the land slopes gently into the sea. Similarly, some supporters of the Celsian theory used to point to the increase of land near river mouths, not fully considering that if the sea bed is rising, the change will always be most apparent where the sea floor has already become shallow. Meanwhile, far from these areas, where steep granitic cliffs drop directly into deep water, a much larger amount of elevation is needed to create an equally noticeable change.

As to the area in northern Europe which is subject to this slow upheaving movement, we have not as yet sufficient data for estimating it correctly. It seems probable, however, that it reaches from Gothenburg to Torneo, and from thence to the North Cape, the rate of elevation increasing always as we proceed farther northwards. The two extremities of this line are more than a thousand geographical miles distant from each other; and as both terminate in the ocean, we know not how much farther the motion may be prolonged under water. As to the breadth of the tract, its limits are equally uncertain, though it evidently extends across the widest parts of the Gulf of Bothnia, and may probably stretch far into the interior, both of Sweden and Finland. Now if the elevation continue, a larger part of the Gulf of Bothnia will be turned into land, as also more of the ocean off the west coast of Sweden between Gothenburg and Uddevalla; and on the other hand, if the change has been going on for thousands of years at the rate of several feet in a century, large tracts of what is now land must have been submarine at periods comparatively modern. It is natural therefore to inquire whether there are any signs of the recent sojourn of the sea on districts now inland? The answer is most satisfactory.—Near Uddevalla and the neighboring coastland, we find upraised deposits of shells belonging to species such as now live in the ocean; while on the opposite or eastern side of Sweden, near Stockholm, Gefle, and other places bordering the Bothnian Gulf, there are analogous beds containing shells of species characteristic of the Baltic.

As for the area in northern Europe that's experiencing this slow uplift, we don't yet have enough data to estimate it accurately. However, it seems likely that it stretches from Gothenburg to Torneo and then up to the North Cape, with the rate of elevation increasing as we go further north. The two ends of this line are more than a thousand geographical miles apart, and since both end in the ocean, we can't tell how much further this movement might continue underwater. As for the width of the area, its boundaries are also unclear, although it clearly spans the widest parts of the Gulf of Bothnia and likely extends deep into both Sweden and Finland. If the elevation continues, a larger portion of the Gulf of Bothnia will become land, as well as more of the ocean off Sweden's west coast between Gothenburg and Uddevalla. Conversely, if this change has been happening for thousands of years at a rate of several feet per century, then large areas that are now land must have been underwater relatively recently. It's natural to ask whether there are any signs of the sea having recently occupied areas that are now inland. The answer is very promising. Near Uddevalla and the surrounding coastal areas, we find raised deposits of shells from species that currently live in the ocean; meanwhile, on the eastern side of Sweden, near Stockholm, Gefle, and other locations around the Bothnian Gulf, there are similar deposits containing shells from species characteristic of the Baltic.

Von Buch announced in 1807, that he had discovered in Norway and at Uddevalla in Sweden, beds of shells of existing species, at considerable heights above the sea. Since that time, other naturalists have confirmed 527 his observation; and, according to Ström, deposits occur at an elevation of more than 400 feet above the sea in the northern part of Norway. M. Alex. Brongniart, when he visited Uddevalla, ascertained that one of the principal masses of shells, that of Capellbacken, is raised more than 200 feet above the sea, resting on rocks of gneiss, all the species being identical with those now inhabiting the contiguous ocean. The same naturalist also stated, that on examining with care the surface of the gneiss, immediately above the ancient shelly deposit, he found barnacles (balani) adhering to the rocks, showing that the sea had remained there for a long time. I was fortunate enough to be able to verify this observation by finding in the summer of 1834, at Kured, about two miles north of Uddevalla, and at the height of more than 100 feet above the sea, a surface of gneiss newly laid open by the partial removal of a mass of shells used largely in the district for making lime and repairing the roads. So firmly did these barnacles adhere to the gneiss, that I broke off portions of the rock with the shells attached. The face of the gneiss was also incrusted with small zoophytes (Cellepora? Lam.); but had these or the barnacles been exposed in the atmosphere ever since the elevation of the rocks above the sea, they would doubtless have decomposed and been obliterated.

Von Buch announced in 1807 that he had found beds of shells from existing species in Norway and at Uddevalla in Sweden, at significant heights above sea level. Since then, other naturalists have confirmed this observation; according to Ström, there are deposits over 400 feet above sea level in northern Norway. M. Alex. Brongniart, when he visited Uddevalla, discovered that one of the main shell masses, at Capellbacken, is raised more than 200 feet above sea level, sitting on gneiss rocks, with all the species matching those currently found in the nearby ocean. This naturalist also noted that when he carefully examined the gneiss surface right above the ancient shell deposit, he found barnacles (balani) clinging to the rocks, indicating that the sea had been there for a long time. I was fortunate enough to confirm this observation in the summer of 1834, at Kured, about two miles north of Uddevalla, at more than 100 feet above sea level, where I found a gneiss surface newly exposed by the partial removal of a large shell mass used extensively in the area for making lime and repairing roads. The barnacles were so firmly attached to the gneiss that I broke off pieces of the rock with the shells still on them. The surface of the gneiss was also covered in small zoophytes (Cellepora? Lam.); however, had these or the barnacles been exposed to the atmosphere since the rocks were elevated above sea level, they would likely have decomposed and disappeared.

The town of Uddevalla (see Map, p. 523) stands at the head of a narrow creek overhung by steep and barren rocks of gneiss, of which all the adjacent country is composed, except in the low grounds and bottoms of valleys, where strata of sand, clay, and marl frequently hide the fundamental rocks. To these newer and horizontal deposits the fossil shells above mentioned belong, and similar marine remains are found at various heights above the sea on the opposite island of Orust. The extreme distance from the sea to which such fossils extend is as yet unknown; but they have been already found at Trollhättan in digging the canal there, and still farther inland on the northern borders of Lake Wener, fifty miles from the sea, at an elevation of 200 feet near Lake Rogvarpen.

The town of Uddevalla (see Map, p. 523) is located at the head of a narrow creek surrounded by steep, bare gneiss rocks, which make up the entire surrounding area, except in the lowlands and valley bottoms where layers of sand, clay, and marl often cover the underlying rocks. The fossil shells mentioned earlier belong to these newer, horizontal deposits, and similar marine remains are found at various elevations above sea level on the nearby island of Orust. The farthest distance from the sea where these fossils have been discovered is still unknown; however, they have already been found at Trollhättan during canal excavation, and even further inland on the northern edge of Lake Wener, fifty miles from the sea, at 200 feet above sea level near Lake Rogvarpen.

To pass to the Baltic: I observed near its shores at Södertelje, sixteen miles S. W. of Stockholm, strata of sand, clay, and marl, more than 100 feet high, and containing shells of species now inhabiting the Bothnian Gulf. These consist partly of marine and partly of freshwater species; but they are few in number, the brackishness of the water appearing to be very unfavorable to the development of testacea. The most abundant species are the common cockle and the common mussel and periwinkle of our shores (Cardium edule, Mytilus edulis, and Littorina littorea), together with a small tellina (T. Baltica) and a few minute univalves allied to Paludina ulva. These live in the same water as a Lymneus, a Neritina (N. fluviatilis), and some other freshwater shells.

To get to the Baltic: I noticed near its shores at Södertelje, sixteen miles southwest of Stockholm, layers of sand, clay, and marl that are over 100 feet high, which contain shells of species currently found in the Bothnian Gulf. These include both marine and freshwater species, but there aren’t many because the brackish water seems to hinder the growth of shellfish. The most common species are the common cockle, common mussel, and periwinkle of our coasts (Cardium edule, Mytilus edulis, and Littorina littorea), along with a small tellina (T. Baltica) and a few tiny univalves related to Paludina ulva. These live alongside a Lymneus, a Neritina (N. fluviatilis), and some other freshwater shells.

But the marine mollusks of the Baltic above mentioned, although very numerous in individuals, are dwarfish in size, scarcely ever attaining a third of the average dimensions which they acquire in the salter waters of 528 the ocean. By this character alone a geologist would generally be able to recognize an assemblage of Baltic fossils as distinguished from those derived from a deposit in the ocean. The absence also of oysters, barnacles, whelks, scallops, limpets (ostrea, balanus, buccinum, pecten, patella), and many other forms abounding alike in the sea near Uddevalla, and in the fossiliferous deposits of modern date on that coast, supplies an additional negative character of the greatest value, distinguishing assemblages of Baltic from those of oceanic shells. Now the strata containing Baltic shells are found in many localities near Stockholm, Upsala, and Gefle, and will probably be discovered everywhere around the borders of the Bothnian Gulf; for I have seen similar remains brought from Finland, in marl resembling that found near Stockholm. The utmost distance to which these deposits have yet been traced inland, is on the southern shores of Lake Maeler, at a place seventy miles from the sea.737 Hence it appears from the distinct assemblage of fossil shells found on the eastern and western coasts of Sweden, that the Baltic has been for a long period separated as now from the ocean, although the intervening tract of land was once much narrower, even after both seas had become inhabited by all the existing species of testacea.

But the marine mollusks of the Baltic mentioned earlier, while abundant in number, are small in size, rarely reaching even a third of the average size they attain in the saltier waters of the ocean. This feature alone would usually allow a geologist to identify a collection of Baltic fossils as different from those sourced from ocean deposits. The lack of oysters, barnacles, whelks, scallops, and limpets (like ostrea, balanus, buccinum, pecten, patella), which are found in the sea near Uddevalla and in the fossil-rich deposits along that coast, provides another significant distinguishing feature that helps separate Baltic shell assemblages from oceanic ones. The layers that contain Baltic shells can be found in many locations near Stockholm, Uppsala, and Gefle, and are likely to be discovered all around the edges of the Bothnian Gulf; I have also seen similar remains brought from Finland in marl similar to that found near Stockholm. The farthest inland that these deposits have been traced is on the southern shores of Lake Maeler, about seventy miles from the sea.737 Therefore, the distinct collections of fossil shells found along the eastern and western coasts of Sweden indicate that the Baltic has long been separated from the ocean as it is today, although the land between was once much narrower, even after both seas were populated by all existing species of testacea.

As no accurate observations on the rise of the Swedish coast refer to periods more remote than a century and a half from the present time, and as traditional information, and that derived from ancient buildings on the coast, do not enable the antiquary to trace back any monuments of change for more than five or six centuries, we cannot declare whether the rate of the upheaving force is uniform during very long periods. In those districts where the fossil shells are found at the height of more than 200 feet above the ocean, as at Uddevalla, Orust, and Lake Rogvarpen, the present rate of rise seems less than four feet in a century. Even at that rate it would have required five thousand years to lift up those deposits. But as the movement is now very different in different places, it may also have varied much in intensity at different eras.

Since there are no reliable observations on the rise of the Swedish coast that go back more than a century and a half, and because traditional information and data from ancient coastal buildings don't allow historians to trace any signs of change for more than five or six centuries, we can't say whether the rate of rising is consistent over very long periods. In areas where fossil shells are found at over 200 feet above sea level, like Uddevalla, Orust, and Lake Rogvarpen, the current rate of rise seems to be under four feet per century. Even at that rate, it would have taken five thousand years to elevate those deposits. However, since the movement varies significantly from place to place now, it may have also changed a lot in intensity throughout different periods.

We have, moreover, yet to learn not only whether the motion proceeds always at the same rate, but also whether it has been uniformly in one direction. The level of the land may oscillate; and for centuries there may be a depression, and afterwards a re-elevation, of the same district. Some phenomena in the neighborhood of Stockholm appear to me only explicable on the supposition of the alternate rising and sinking of the ground since the country was inhabited by man. In digging a canal, in 1819, at Södertelje, about sixteen miles to the south of Stockholm, to unite Lake Maeler with the Baltic, marine strata, containing fossil shells of Baltic species, were passed through. At a depth of about sixty feet, they came down upon what seems to have been a buried fishing-hut, constructed of wood in a state of decomposition, which soon crumbled away on exposure to the air. The lowest part, however, which had stood on a level with the sea, was in a more perfect state of preservation. On 529 the floor of this hut was a rude fireplace, consisting of a ring of stones, and within this were cinders and charred wood. On the outside lay boughs of the fir, cut as with an axe, with the leaves or needles still attached. It seems very difficult to explain the position of this buried hut, without imagining, as in the case of the temple of Serapis (see p. 486), first a subsidence to the depth of more than sixty feet, then a reelevation. During the period of submergence, the hut must have become covered over with gravel and shelly marl, under which not only the hut, but several vessels also were found, of a very antique form, and having their timbers fastened together by wooden pegs instead of nails.738

We still need to figure out not just if the motion happens at a constant rate, but also if it's always going in one direction. The land level can fluctuate; for centuries, a region may sink and then rise again. Some events around Stockholm only make sense to me if we consider the land alternately rising and sinking since humans first lived there. When digging a canal in 1819 at Södertelje, about sixteen miles south of Stockholm, to connect Lake Maeler with the Baltic Sea, workers discovered marine layers containing fossil shells of Baltic species. At a depth of about sixty feet, they found what seemed to be a buried fishing hut made of wood that quickly fell apart when exposed to air. The bottom part, which had been level with the sea, was better preserved. Inside the hut was a basic fireplace made of stones, containing ashes and burned wood. Outside, they found fir branches that had been cut with an axe, with the leaves or needles still attached. It's hard to explain why this hut was buried without imagining a process like what happened to the temple of Serapis (see p. 486), where the land first sank over sixty feet and then rose again. During the time it was submerged, the hut must have been covered with gravel and shelly marl, and under that, several ancient vessels were also found, built in a very old style and held together with wooden pegs instead of nails.738

Whether any of the land in Norway is now rising, must be determined by future investigations. Marine fossil shells, of recent species, have been collected from inland places near Drontheim; but Mr. Everest, in his "Travels through Norway," informs us that the small island of Munkholm, which is an insulated rock in the harbor of Drontheim, affords conclusive evidence of the land having in that region remained stationary for the last eight centuries. The area of this isle does not exceed that of a small village, and by an official survey, its highest point has been determined to be twenty-three feet above the mean highwater mark, that is, the mean between neap and spring tides. Now, a monastery was founded there by Canute the Great, A. D. 1028, and thirty-three years before that time it was in use as a common place of execution. According to the assumed average rate of rise in Sweden (about forty inches in a century), we should be obliged to suppose that this island had been three feet eight inches below high-water mark when it was originally chosen as the site of the monastery.

Whether any of the land in Norway is currently rising needs to be figured out through future studies. Marine fossil shells from recent species have been found in inland areas near Trondheim; however, Mr. Everest, in his "Travels through Norway," tells us that the small island of Munkholm, which is a standalone rock in the harbor of Trondheim, provides clear evidence that the land in that region has stayed the same for the last eight centuries. The size of this island is about that of a small village, and an official survey has determined that its highest point is twenty-three feet above the average high water mark, which is the average between neap and spring tides. Now, a monastery was established there by Canute the Great in A.D. 1028, and thirty-three years before that, it was used as a common place of execution. Based on the presumed average rate of land rise in Sweden (around forty inches per century), we would have to assume that this island was three feet eight inches below the high-water mark when it was originally chosen as the location for the monastery.

Professor Keilhau of Christiania, after collecting the observations of his predecessors respecting former changes of level in Norway, and combining them with his own, has made the fact of a general change of level at a modern period, that is to say, within the period of the actual testaceous fauna, very evident. He infers that the whole country from Cape Lindesnæs to Cape North, and beyond that as far as the fortress of Vardhuus, has been gradually upraised, and on the southeast coast the elevation has amounted to more than 600 feet. The marks which denote the ancient coast-line are so nearly horizontal that the deviation from horizontality, although the measurements have been made at a great number of points, is too small to be appreciated.

Professor Keilhau from Christiania gathered information from previous researchers about past changes in land levels in Norway and combined it with his own findings. He clearly shows that there has been a general change in land level in recent times, specifically during the period of the existing shellfish fauna. He concludes that the entire country from Cape Lindesnæs to Cape North, and further up to the fortress of Vardhuus, has gradually risen, with the southeastern coast experiencing an elevation of more than 600 feet. The indicators of the old coastline are so nearly level that the slight variations from being horizontal, despite measurements taken at many locations, are too minimal to notice.

More recently (1844), however, it appears from the researches of M. Bravais, member of the French scientific commission of the North, that in the Gulf of Alten in Finmark, the most northerly part of Norway, 530 there are two distinct lines of upraised ancient sea-coast, one above the other, which are not parallel, and both of them imply that within a distance of fifty miles a considerable slope can be detected in such a direction as to show that the ancient shores have undergone a greater amount of upheaval in proportion as we advance inland.739

More recently (1844), however, research by M. Bravais, a member of the French scientific commission for the North, has shown that in the Gulf of Alten in Finmark, the northernmost part of Norway, 530 there are two distinct lines of raised ancient coastlines, one above the other, which are not parallel. Both lines indicate that within a distance of fifty miles, there is a noticeable slope suggesting that the ancient shores have experienced more upheaval as one moves further inland.739

It has been already stated, that, in proceeding from the North Cape to Stockholm, the rate of upheaval diminishes from several feet to a few inches in a century. To the south of Stockholm, the upward movement ceases, and at length in Scania, or the southernmost part of Sweden, it appears to give place to a movement in an opposite direction. In proof of this fact, Professor Nilsson observes, in the first place, that there are no elevated beds of recent marine shells in Scania like those farther to the north. Secondly, Linnæus, with a view of ascertaining whether the waters of the Baltic were retiring from the Scanian shore, measured, in 1749, the distance between the sea and a large stone near Trelleborg. This same stone was, in 1836, a hundred feet nearer the water's edge than in Linnæus's time, or eighty-seven years before. Thirdly, there is also a submerged peat moss, consisting of land and freshwater plants, beneath the sea at a point to which no peat could have been drifted down by any river. Fourthly, and what is still more conclusive, it is found that in seaport towns, all along the coast of Scania, there are streets below the high-water level of the Baltic, and in some cases below the level of the lowest tide. Thus, when the wind is high at Malmo, the water overflows one of the present streets, and some years ago some excavations showed an ancient street in the same place eight feet lower, and it was then seen that there had been an artificial raising of the ground, doubtless in consequence of that subsidence. There is also a street at Trelleborg, and another at Skanör, a few inches below high-water mark, and a street at Ystad is exactly on a level with the sea, at which it could not have been originally built.

It has already been noted that when going from North Cape to Stockholm, the rate of uplift decreases from several feet to just a few inches per century. South of Stockholm, the upward movement stops, and eventually in Scania, the southernmost part of Sweden, it seems to reverse direction. To support this, Professor Nilsson points out that, first, there are no elevated beds of recent marine shells in Scania like those found further north. Second, Linnæus, in an effort to determine if the Baltic Sea was receding from the Scanian shore, measured the distance between the sea and a large stone near Trelleborg in 1749. In 1836, the same stone was found to be a hundred feet closer to the water's edge than it had been in Linnæus's time, eighty-seven years earlier. Third, there is also a submerged peat moss made up of land and freshwater plants beneath the sea in a location where no peat could have been carried by any river. Fourth, and even more convincing, it has been discovered that in seaport towns along the Scania coast, there are streets that lie below the high-water level of the Baltic, and in some cases, below the level of the lowest tide. Consequently, when there are high winds in Malmo, the water floods one of the current streets, and years ago, excavations revealed an ancient street in the same spot that was eight feet lower. It became clear that the ground had been artificially raised, likely due to that subsidence. There is also a street in Trelleborg and another in Skanör that are a few inches below high-water mark, and a street in Ystad is exactly level with the sea, suggesting it couldn't have originally been built there.

The inferences deduced from the foregoing facts are in perfect harmony with the proofs brought to light by two Danish investigators, Dr. Pingel and Captain Graah, of the sinking down of part of the west coast of Greenland, for a space of more than 600 miles from north to south. The observations of Captain Graah were made during a survey of Greenland in 1823-24; and afterwards in 1828-29; those by Dr. Pingel were made in 1830-32. It appears from various signs and traditions, that the coast has been subsiding for the last four centuries from the firth called Igaliko, in lat. 60° 43' N. to Disco Bay, extending to nearly the 69th degree of north latitude. Ancient buildings on low rocky islands and on the shore of the main land have been gradually submerged, and experience has taught the aboriginal Greenlander never to build his hut near the water's edge. In one case the Moravian settlers have been obliged more than once to move inland the poles upon 531 which their large boats were set, and the old poles still remain beneath the water as silent witnesses of the change.740

The conclusions drawn from the facts above align perfectly with the evidence uncovered by two Danish researchers, Dr. Pingel and Captain Graah, about the gradual sinking of part of the west coast of Greenland, extending over 600 miles from north to south. Captain Graah made his observations during a survey of Greenland in 1823-24, and again in 1828-29, while Dr. Pingel's observations took place between 1830 and 1832. Various signs and traditions suggest that the coast has been subsiding for the last four centuries, from the fjord known as Igaliko, at latitude 60° 43' N., to Disco Bay, reaching nearly up to the 69th degree of north latitude. Ancient structures on low rocky islands and along the main coastline have been gradually submerged, and experience has taught the indigenous Greenlanders to avoid building their huts close to the water's edge. In one instance, the Moravian settlers have had to relocate several times the poles on which their large boats were placed, moving them further inland, while the old poles still lie underwater as silent witnesses to the change. 531 740

The probable cause of the movements above alluded to, whether of elevation or depression, will be more appropriately discussed in the following chapters, when the origin of subterranean heat is considered. But I may remark here, that the rise of Scandinavia has naturally been regarded as a very singular and scarcely credible phenomenon, because no region on the globe has been more free within the times of authentic history from violent earthquakes. In common, indeed, with our own island and with almost every spot on the globe, some movements have been, at different periods, experienced, both in Norway and Sweden. But some of these, as for example during the Lisbon earthquake in 1755, may have been mere vibrations or undulatory movements of the earth's crust prolonged from a great distance. Others, however, have been sufficiently local to indicate a source of disturbance immediately under the country itself. Notwithstanding these shocks, Scandinavia has, upon the whole, been as tranquil in modern times, and as free from subterranean convulsions, as any region of equal extent on the globe. There is also another circumstance which has made the change of level in Sweden appear anomalous, and has for a long time caused the proofs of the fact to be received with reluctance. Volcanic action, as we have seen, is usually intermittent: and the variations of level to which it has given rise have taken place by starts, not by a prolonged and insensible movement similar to that experienced in Sweden. Yet, as we enlarge our experience of modern changes, we discover instances in which the volcanic eruption, the earthquake, and the permanent rise or fall of land, whether slow or sudden, are all connected. The union of these various circumstances was exemplified in the case of the temple of Serapis, described in the last chapter, and we might derive other illustrations from the events of the present century in South America.

The likely reason for the movements mentioned earlier, whether upward or downward, will be discussed more thoroughly in the upcoming chapters when we look at the source of underground heat. However, I should point out that Scandinavia's rise is often seen as a very unusual and hard-to-believe occurrence, since no other area on the planet has been as free from major earthquakes during recorded history. Like our own island and almost every location around the world, Norway and Sweden have experienced some movements at different times. Some of these, such as during the Lisbon earthquake in 1755, might have just been vibrations or waves in the earth's crust caused by distant events. Others have been local enough to suggest disturbances occurring right beneath the country. Despite these shocks, Scandinavia has generally been as calm in recent times, and as free from underground upheavals, as any similarly sized area on Earth. Another factor that makes the level change in Sweden seem strange is that it has led to skepticism about the evidence for it. Volcanic activity, as we've noted, is usually sporadic, and the level changes it causes happen abruptly, rather than through a steady and imperceptible process like that in Sweden. Yet, as we broaden our understanding of modern changes, we find examples where volcanic eruptions, earthquakes, and the permanent rising or sinking of land, whether slow or fast, are all related. This combination of factors was illustrated in the case of the temple of Serapis, described in the last chapter, and we can find more examples from events in South America in this century.

Some writers, indeed, have imagined that there is geological evidence in Norway, of the sudden upheaval of land to a considerable height at successive periods, since the era when the sea was inhabited by the living species of testacea. They point in proof to certain horizontal lines of inland cliffs and sea-beaches containing recent shells at various heights above the level of the sea.741 But these appearances, when truly interpreted, simply prove that there have been long pauses in the process of upheaval or subsidence. They mark eras at which the level of the sea has remained stationary for ages, and during which new strata were deposited near the shore in some places, while in others the waves and currents had time to hollow out rocks, undermine cliffs, and throw up long ranges of shingle. They undoubtedly show that the movement has not been always uniform or continuous, but they do not establish the fact of any sudden alterations of level.

Some writers have imagined that there is geological evidence in Norway of the sudden rise of land to a significant height at different times since the period when the sea was home to living species of shellfish. They point out certain horizontal lines of inland cliffs and sea beaches containing recent shells at various heights above sea level.741 However, when these features are properly understood, they simply indicate that there have been long pauses in the process of rising or sinking. They mark times when the sea level has stayed the same for ages, during which new layers were deposited near the shore in some places, while in others, waves and currents had time to erode rocks, undercut cliffs, and build up long stretches of pebbles. They certainly show that the movement hasn't always been steady or continuous, but they don't prove that there have been any sudden changes in level.

532 When we are once assured of the reality of the gradual rise of a large region, it enables us to account for many geological appearances otherwise of very difficult explanation. There are large continental tracts and high table-lands where the strata are nearly horizontal, bearing no marks of having been thrown up by violent convulsions, nor by a series of movements, such as those which occur in the Andes, and cause the earth to be rent open, and raised or depressed from time to time, while large masses are engulfed in subterranean cavities. The result of a series of such earthquakes might be to produce in a great lapse of ages a country of shattered, inclined, and perhaps vertical strata. But a movement like that of Scandinavia would cause the bed of the sea, and all the strata recently formed in it, to be upheaved so gradually, that it would merely seem as if the ocean had formerly stood at a higher level, and had slowly and tranquilly sunk down into its present bed.

532 Once we are confident in the reality of a large region slowly rising, it helps us explain many geological features that are otherwise hard to understand. There are large continental areas and high plateaus where the rock layers are nearly flat, showing no signs of being forced up by violent movements or a series of shifts like those in the Andes, which cause the earth to crack open and be lifted or lowered over time, while large sections are swallowed up in underground spaces. The outcome of a series of such earthquakes could lead, over a long enough time, to a landscape of broken, slanted, and possibly vertical rock layers. However, a movement like that in Scandinavia would cause the sea floor and all the layers recently formed there to rise so gradually that it would only look like the ocean used to be at a higher level and slowly and peacefully sunk down into its current position.

The fact also of a very gradual and insensible elevation of land may explain many geological movements of denudation, on a grand scale. If, for example, instead of the hard granitic rocks of Norway and Sweden, a large part of the bed of the Atlantic, consisting chiefly of soft strata, should rise up century after century, at the rate of about half an inch, or an inch, in a year, how easily might oceanic currents sweep away the thin film of matter thus brought up annually within the sphere of aqueous denudation! The tract, when it finally emerged, might present table-lands and ridges of horizontal strata, with intervening valleys and vast plains, where originally, and during its period of submergence, the surface was level and nearly uniform.

The slow and almost undetectable rise of land can help explain many large-scale geological processes of erosion. For instance, if a significant portion of the Atlantic floor, which is mainly made up of soft sediments, were to gradually lift up by about half an inch to an inch each year, it would be easy for ocean currents to wash away the thin layer of material that gets brought up each year through erosion. When this area finally surfaces, it might show flat plateaus and ridges of horizontal layers, along with valleys and vast plains, where the landscape was originally smooth and consistent during its time underwater.

These speculations relate to superficial changes; but others must be continually in progress in the subterranean regions. The foundations of the country, thus gradually uplifted in Sweden, must be undergoing important modifications. Whether we ascribe these to the expansion of solid matter by continually increasing heat, or to the liquefaction of rock, or to the crystallization of a dense fluid, or the accumulation of pent-up gases, in whatever conjectures we indulge, we can never doubt for a moment, that at some unknown depth beneath Sweden and the Baltic, the structure of the globe is in our own times becoming changed from day to day, throughout a space probably more than a thousand miles in length, and several hundred in breadth.

These theories are about surface-level changes, but there are definitely deeper changes happening beneath the surface. The foundations of the land in Sweden, which are gradually rising, must be experiencing significant transformations. Whether we think these changes are due to the expansion of solid matter from increasing heat, the melting of rock, the crystallization of a thick fluid, or the buildup of trapped gases, no matter what ideas we entertain, we can never doubt for a second that at some unknown depth under Sweden and the Baltic Sea, the structure of the Earth is changing day by day, across an area likely over a thousand miles long and several hundred miles wide.


CHAPTER XXXI.

CAUSES OF EARTHQUAKES AND VOLCANOES.

Intimate connection between the causes of volcanoes and earthquakes—Supposed original state of fusion of the planet—Universal fluidity not proved by spheroidal figure of the earth—Attempt to calculate the thickness of the solid crust of the earth by precessional motion—Heat in mines increasing with the depth—Objections to the supposed intense heat of a central fluid—Whether chemical changes may produce volcanic heat—Currents of electricity circulating in the earth's crust.

Intimate connection between the causes of volcanoes and earthquakes—Supposed original state of fusion of the planet—Universal fluidity not proved by the spheroidal shape of the earth—Efforts to calculate the thickness of the earth's solid crust through precessional motion—Heat in mines rising with depth—Arguments against the idea of an intensely hot central fluid—Exploration of whether chemical changes can create volcanic heat—Electric currents flowing within the earth's crust.

It will hardly be questioned, after the description before given of the phenomena of earthquakes and volcanoes, that both of these agents have, to a certain extent, a common origin; and I may now, therefore, proceed to inquire into their probable causes. But first, it may be well to recapitulate some of those points of relation and analogy which lead naturally to the conclusion that they spring from a common source.

It’s almost undisputed, after the previous description of the phenomena of earthquakes and volcanoes, that both of these forces share, to some degree, a common origin; so now, I can move on to exploring their likely causes. But first, it’s useful to recap some of the points of connection and similarity that naturally suggest they originate from the same source.

The regions convulsed by violent earthquakes include within them the site of all the active volcanoes. Earthquakes, sometimes local, sometimes extending over vast areas, often precede volcanic eruptions. The subterranean movement and the eruption return again and again, at irregular intervals of time, and with unequal degrees of force, to the same spots. The action of either may continue for a few hours, or for several consecutive years. Paroxysmal convulsions are usually followed, in both cases, by long periods of tranquillity. Thermal and mineral springs are abundant in countries of earthquakes and active volcanoes. Lastly, hot springs situated in districts considerably distant from volcanic vents have been observed to have their temperature suddenly raised, and the volume of their water augmented, by subterranean movements.

The areas affected by strong earthquakes also happen to be home to all the active volcanoes. Earthquakes, which can be localized or cover large regions, often occur before volcanic eruptions. The underground movement and eruptions repeatedly happen at irregular intervals, with varying levels of intensity, in the same locations. The effects of either can last for a few hours or go on for several years in a row. Intense shaking is typically followed by long stretches of calm in both cases. Thermal and mineral springs are plentiful in regions with earthquakes and active volcanoes. Additionally, hot springs located far from volcanic vents have been noted to suddenly increase in temperature and water volume due to underground movements.

All these appearances are evidently more or less connected with the passage of heat from the interior of the earth to the surface; and where there are active volcanoes, there must exist, at some unknown depth below, enormous masses of matter intensely heated, and, in many instances, in a constant state of fusion. We have first, then, to inquire, whence is this heat derived?

All these appearances are clearly connected to the transfer of heat from the earth's interior to the surface. Where there are active volcanoes, there must be huge amounts of intensely heated material lurking at some unknown depth below, often in a state of constant melting. So, first, we need to ask: where does this heat come from?

It has long been a favorite conjecture, that the whole of our planet was originally in a state of igneous fusion, and that the central parts still retain a great portion of their primitive heat. Some have imagined, with the late Sir W. Herschel, that the elementary matter of the earth may have been first in a gaseous state, resembling those nebulæ which we behold in the heavens, and which are of dimensions so vast, that some of them would fill the orbits of the remotest planets of our system. The increased power of the telescope has of late years resolved the greater number of these nebulous appearances into clusters of stars, but so long 534 as they were confidently supposed to consist of aeriform matter it was a favorite conjecture that they might, if concentrated, form solid spheres; and it was also imagined that the evolution of heat, attendant on condensation, might retain the materials of the new globes in a state of igneous fusion.

It has long been a popular idea that our planet was initially in a molten state, and that the core still holds a lot of its original heat. Some people, including the late Sir W. Herschel, have speculated that the earth’s basic materials might have first existed in a gaseous form, similar to the nebulae we see in the sky, which are so large that some could fit within the orbits of the farthest planets in our solar system. Recent advancements in telescope technology have clarified that most of these nebulae are actually clusters of stars. However, as long as they were believed to be made up of gaseous matter, it was a common thought that if they were condensed, they could form solid spheres; it was also thought that the heat generated during this process of condensation could keep the materials of these new spheres in a molten state.

Without dwelling on such speculations, which can only have a distant bearing on geology, we may consider how far the spheroidal form of the earth affords sufficient ground for presuming that its primitive condition was one of universal fluidity. The discussion of this question would be superfluous, were the doctrine of original fluidity less popular; for it may well be asked, why the globe should be supposed to have had a pristine shape different from the present one?—why the terrestrial materials, when first called into existence, or assembled together in one place, should not have been subject to rotation, so as to assume at once that form which alone could retain their several parts in a state of equilibrium?

Without getting into such speculations, which only have a vague relevance to geology, we can consider how much the Earth's spherical shape supports the idea that its original state was one of complete fluidity. Discussing this topic would be pointless if the idea of original fluidity wasn't so widely accepted; it raises an interesting question: why should we think that the Earth had a different shape in its early days? Why couldn't the materials that existed initially, or were gathered together in one place, have been rotating, so they could immediately take on the shape that would keep their parts balanced?

Let us, however, concede that the statical figure may be a modification of some other pre-existing form, and suppose the globe to have been at first a perfect and quiescent sphere, covered with a uniform ocean—what would happen when it was made to turn round on its axis with its present velocity? This problem has been considered by Playfair in his Illustrations, and he has decided, that if the surface of the earth, as laid down in Hutton's theory, has been repeatedly changed by the transportation of the detritus of the land to the bottom of the sea, the figure of the planet must in that case, whatever it may have been originally, be brought at length to coincide with the spheroid of equilibrium.742 Sir John Herschel also, in reference to the same hypothesis, observes, "a centrifugal force would in that case be generated, whose general tendency would be to urge the water at every point of the surface to recede from the axis. A rotation might indeed be conceived so swift as to flirt the whole ocean from the surface, like water from a mop. But this would require a far greater velocity than what we now speak of. In the case supposed, the weight of the water would still keep it on the earth; and the tendency to recede from the axis could only be satisfied therefore by the water leaving the poles, and flowing towards the equator; there heaping itself up in a ridge, and being retained in opposition to its weight or natural tendency towards the centre by the pressure thus caused. This, however, could not take place without laying dry the polar regions, so that protuberant land would appear at the poles, and a zone of ocean be disposed around the equator. This would be the first or immediate effect. Let us now see what would afterwards happen if things were allowed to take their natural course.

Let’s acknowledge that the current shape of the earth might be a result of modifications to some earlier form. Imagine the globe was initially a perfect, still sphere entirely covered by a uniform ocean—what would occur if it began rotating on its axis at its present speed? Playfair examined this issue in his Illustrations and concluded that if the surface of the earth, as described in Hutton's theory, has continuously changed due to the movement of land debris to the ocean floor, then the planet's shape, regardless of its original form, would eventually align with the equilibrium spheroid.742 Sir John Herschel also comments on this theory, noting that "a centrifugal force would then be generated, which would generally push the water at every point on the surface to move away from the axis. It's conceivable to imagine a rotation so fast that it would fling the entire ocean off the surface, like water from a mop. However, this would require a much greater speed than what we're discussing now. In the scenario described, the weight of the water would still keep it on the earth; the force pushing away from the axis could only be met by the water moving away from the poles toward the equator. There it would pile up in a ridge, held in place against its weight or its natural pull toward the center by the pressure created. However, this situation couldn't happen without drying out the polar regions, leading to raised land at the poles and a surrounding zone of ocean around the equator. This would be the immediate effect. Now, let’s explore what would happen next if things were allowed to proceed naturally.

"The sea is constantly beating on the land, grinding it down, and scattering its worn-off particles and fragments, in the state of sand and pebbles, over its bed. Geological facts afford abundant proof that the 535 existing continents have all of them undergone this process even more than once, and been entirely torn in fragments, or reduced to powder, and submerged and reconstructed. Land, in this view of the subject, loses its attribute of fixity. As a mass it might hold together in opposition to forces which the water freely obeys; but in its state of successive or simultaneous degradation, when disseminated through the water, in the state of sand or mud, it is subject to all the impulses of that fluid. In the lapse of time, then, the protuberant land would be destroyed, and spread over the bottom of the ocean, filling up the lower parts, and tending continually to remodel the surface of the solid nucleus, in correspondence with the form of equilibrium. Thus after a sufficient lapse of time, in the case of an earth in rotation, the polar protuberances would gradually be cut down and disappear, being transferred to the equator (as being then the deepest sea), till the earth would assume by degrees the form we observe it to have—that of a flattened or oblate ellipsoid.

"The sea is constantly crashing against the land, wearing it down and spreading its eroded particles and fragments, turning them into sand and pebbles over the ocean floor. Geological evidence clearly shows that the 535 existing continents have gone through this process multiple times, being completely broken apart, ground down, submerged, and rebuilt. From this perspective, land loses its sense of permanence. While it may hold together against forces that water easily yields to, when it breaks down into sand or mud and gets mixed with water, it becomes vulnerable to all the movements of that fluid. Over time, the elevated land would erode and settle on the ocean floor, filling in the lower areas and continuously reshaping the surface of the solid core in line with the form of equilibrium. Thus, given enough time in a rotating earth, the higher land masses would gradually wear away and disappear, shifting towards the equator (as it would be then the deepest sea), until the earth gradually takes on the shape we see today—a flattened or oblate ellipsoid."

"We are far from meaning here to trace the process by which the earth really assumed its actual form; all we intend is to show that this is the form to which, under a condition of a rotation on its axis, it must tend, and which it would attain even if originally and (so to speak) perversely constituted otherwise."743

"We definitely don't intend to outline the process by which the earth actually took on its current shape; our only goal is to demonstrate that this is the shape to which, given a condition of rotation on its axis, it must tend, and which it would achieve even if it were originally and (so to speak) oddly formed otherwise."743

In this passage, the author has contemplated the superficial effects of aqueous causes only; but neither he nor Playfair seem to have followed out the same inquiry with reference to another part of Hutton's system; namely, that which assumes the successive fusion by heat of different parts of the solid earth. Yet the progress of geology has continually strengthened the evidence in favor of the doctrine that local variations of temperature have melted one part after another of the earth's crust, and this influence has perhaps extended downwards to the very centre. If, therefore, before the globe had assumed its present form, it was made to revolve on its axis, all matter to which freedom of motion was given by fusion, must before consolidating have been impelled towards the equatorial regions in obedience to the centrifugal force. Thus lava flowing out in superficial streams would have its motion retarded when its direction was towards the pole, accelerated when towards the equator; or if lakes and seas of lava existed beneath the earth's crust in equatorial regions, as probably now beneath the Peruvian Andes, the imprisoned fluid would force outwards and permanently upheave the overlying rocks. The statical figure, therefore, of the terrestrial spheroid (of which the longest diameter exceeds the shortest by about twenty-five miles), may have been the result of gradual and even of existing causes, and not of a primitive, universal, and simultaneous fluidity.744

In this passage, the author has considered only the obvious effects of water-based causes; however, neither he nor Playfair appears to have investigated another aspect of Hutton's theory, which involves the gradual melting by heat of different areas of the solid earth. Nonetheless, the advancement of geology has consistently reinforced the evidence supporting the idea that local temperature variations have caused parts of the earth's crust to melt one after the other, and this process might have even extended down to the core. Therefore, if, prior to the earth taking its current shape, it was rotating on its axis, any material that had the freedom to move due to melting would have been pushed toward the equatorial regions because of centrifugal force before solidifying. As a result, lava flowing out in surface streams would experience slowed motion when moving toward the pole and accelerated motion when moving toward the equator; or if there were lakes and seas of lava beneath the earth's crust in equatorial areas, likely similar to what exists now beneath the Peruvian Andes, the trapped liquid would push outward and permanently uplift the rocks above it. The overall shape of the earth’s spheroid (where the longest diameter is about twenty-five miles longer than the shortest) may have resulted from gradual and even ongoing processes, rather than a primitive, universal, and simultaneous state of fluidity.744

Experiments made with the pendulum, and observations on the manner in which the earth attracts the moon, have shown that our planet is 536 not an empty sphere, but, on the contrary, that its interior, whether solid or fluid, has a higher specific gravity than the exterior. It has also been inferred, that there is a regular increase in density from the surface towards the centre, and that the equatorial protuberance is continued inwards; that is to say, that layers of equal density are arranged elliptically, and symmetrically, from the exterior to the centre. These conclusions, however, have been deduced rather as a consequence of the hypothesis of primitive and simultaneous fluidity than proved by experiment. The inequalities in the moon's motion, by which some have endeavored to confirm them, are so extremely slight, that the opinion can be regarded as little more than a probable conjecture.

Experiments with the pendulum and observations on how the Earth attracts the moon have shown that our planet is 536 not just an empty sphere. Instead, its interior, whether solid or liquid, has a higher specific gravity than its surface. It has also been suggested that there is a regular increase in density from the surface to the center, and that the equatorial bulge continues inward. In other words, layers of equal density are organized in an elliptical and symmetrical way from the outside to the center. However, these conclusions are more of a result of the idea of primitive and simultaneous fluidity than proven by actual experiments. The slight irregularities in the moon's motion that some have tried to use to support these ideas are so minimal that the view can be seen as little more than a likely guess.

The mean density of the earth has been computed by Laplace to be about 5½, or more than five times that of water. Now the specific gravity of many of our rocks is from 2½ to 3, and the greater part of the metals range between that density and 21. Hence some have imagined that the terrestrial nucleus may be metallic—that it may correspond, for example, with the specific gravity of iron, which is about 7. But here a curious question arises in regard to the form which materials, whether fluid or solid, might assume, if subjected to the enormous pressure which must obtain at the earth's centre. Water, if it continued to decrease in volume according to the rate of compressibility deduced from experiment, would have its density doubled at the depth of ninety-three miles, and be as heavy as mercury at the depth of 362 miles. Dr. Young computed that, at the earth's centre, steel would be compressed into one-fourth, and stone into one-eighth of its bulk.745 It is more than probable, however, that after a certain degree of condensation, the compressibility of bodies may be governed by laws altogether different from those which we can put to the test of experiment; but the limit is still undetermined, and the subject is involved in such obscurity, that we cannot wonder at the variety of notions which have been entertained respecting the nature and conditions of the central nucleus. Some have conceived it to be fluid, others solid; some have imagined it to have a cavernous structure, and have even endeavored to confirm this opinion by appealing to observed irregularities in the vibrations of the pendulum in certain countries.

The average density of the Earth has been calculated by Laplace to be about 5½, which is more than five times that of water. The specific gravity of many of our rocks ranges from 2½ to 3, and most metals fall between that density and 21. Because of this, some people have speculated that the Earth's core might be metallic, possibly matching the specific gravity of iron, which is around 7. However, a curious question arises regarding the form that materials, whether fluid or solid, might take under the immense pressure found at the Earth's center. Water, if it continued to lose volume at the compressibility rate determined by experiments, would have its density doubled at a depth of ninety-three miles, and be as dense as mercury at a depth of 362 miles. Dr. Young calculated that, at the Earth's center, steel would be compressed to one-fourth of its volume, and stone to one-eighth of its size.745 However, it is likely that after a certain level of compression, the way materials compress may follow completely different laws than those we can test experimentally; yet, the limit remains unknown, and the topic is so unclear that we can understand the various theories about the nature and conditions of the central core. Some have imagined it to be fluid, others solid; some have proposed that it has a cavernous structure and even tried to support this idea by referencing observed irregularities in pendulum vibrations in certain regions.

An attempt has recently been made by Mr. Hopkins to determine the least thickness which can be assigned to the solid crust of the globe, if we assume the whole to have been once perfectly fluid, and a certain portion of the exterior to have acquired solidity by gradual refrigeration. This result he has endeavored to obtain by a new solution of the delicate problem of the processional motion of the pole of the earth. It is well known that while the earth revolves round the sun the direction of its axis remains very nearly the same, i. e. its different positions in space are all nearly parallel to each other. This parallelism, however, is not 537 accurately preserved, so that the axis, instead of coming exactly into the position which it occupied a year before, becomes inclined to it at a very small angle, but always retaining very nearly the same inclination to the plane of the earth's orbit. This motion of the pole changes the position of the equinoxes by about fifty seconds annually, and always in the same direction. Thus the pole-star, after a certain time, will entirely lose its claim to that appellation, until in the course of somewhat more than 25,000 years the earth's axis shall again occupy its present angular position, and again point very nearly as now to the pole-star. This motion of the axis is called precession. It is caused by the attraction of the sun and moon, and principally the moon, on the protuberant parts of the earth's equator; and if these parts were solid to a great depth, the motion thus produced would differ considerably from that which would exist if they were perfectly fluid, and incrusted over with a thin shell only a few miles thick. In other words, the disturbing action of the moon will not be the same upon a globe all solid and upon one nearly all fluid, or it will not be the same upon a globe in which the solid shell forms one-half of the mass, and another in which it forms only one-tenth.

Recently, Mr. Hopkins made an attempt to determine the minimum thickness that can be assigned to the solid crust of the Earth, assuming that the entire planet was once completely fluid and that a part of its outer layer became solid due to gradual cooling. He aimed to achieve this result through a new solution to the complex problem of the Earth’s pole's precessional motion. It is well known that while the Earth orbits the sun, the direction of its axis remains nearly constant, meaning its various positions in space are all almost parallel to each other. However, this parallelism is not perfectly maintained, so the axis, instead of returning exactly to the position it held a year ago, tilts at a very slight angle, while still maintaining nearly the same angle to the plane of the Earth's orbit. This movement of the pole shifts the position of the equinoxes by about fifty seconds each year, and always in the same direction. Therefore, the pole star will eventually lose its title, until after over 25,000 years, the Earth's axis returns to its current angle and points almost directly at the pole star again. This motion of the axis is known as precession. It is caused by the gravitational pull of the sun and moon, primarily the moon, on the bulging parts of the Earth's equator; if these regions were solid to a great depth, the resulting motion would differ significantly from that of a planet with a fluid interior and just a thin outer shell a few miles thick. In simpler terms, the moon's disruptive influence will vary between a completely solid globe and one that is mainly fluid, or between one where the solid shell constitutes half the mass and one where it makes up only one-tenth.

Mr. Hopkins has, therefore, calculated the amount of precessional motion which would result if we assume the earth to be constituted as above stated; i. e. fluid internally, and enveloped by a solid shell; and he finds that the amount will not agree with the observed motion, unless the crust of the earth be of a certain thickness. In calculating the exact amount some ambiguity arises in consequence of our ignorance of the effect of pressure in promoting the solidification of matter at high temperatures. The hypothesis least favorable for a great thickness is found to be that which assumes the pressure to produce no effect on the process of solidification. Even on this extreme assumption the thickness of the solid crust must be nearly four hundred miles, and this would lead to the remarkable result that the proportion of the solid to the fluid part would be as 49 to 51, or, to speak in round numbers, there would be nearly as much solid as fluid matter in the globe. The conclusion, however, which Mr. Hopkins announces as that to which his researches have finally conducted him, is thus expressed: "Upon the whole, then, we may venture to assert that the minimum thickness of the crust of the globe, which can be deemed consistent with the observed amount of precession, cannot be less than one-fourth or one-fifth of the earth's radius." That is from 800 to 1000 miles.746

Mr. Hopkins has calculated the amount of precessional motion that would occur if we assume the Earth is structured as mentioned earlier; that is, it has a fluid interior and is surrounded by a solid shell. He finds that the amount won’t match the observed motion unless the Earth’s crust has a specific thickness. When calculating the exact amount, some uncertainty arises because we don’t fully understand how pressure affects the solidification of matter at high temperatures. The least favorable hypothesis for a great thickness assumes that pressure has no effect on solidification. Even under this extreme assumption, the thickness of the solid crust would need to be nearly 400 miles, which would lead to the interesting result that the ratio of solid to fluid parts would be 49 to 51, meaning there would be nearly as much solid material as fluid in the globe. However, the conclusion Mr. Hopkins reaches from his research is stated as follows: "Overall, we may assert that the minimum thickness of the Earth's crust, consistent with the observed amount of precession, cannot be less than one-fourth or one-fifth of the Earth's radius." That is from 800 to 1,000 miles.746

It will be remarked, that this is a minimum, and any still greater amount would be quite consistent with the actual phenomena; the calculations not being opposed to the supposition of the general solidity of the entire globe. Nor do they preclude us from imagining that great lakes or seas of melted matter may be distributed through a shell 400 or 800 538 miles thick, provided they be so inclosed as to move with it, whatever motion of rotation may be communicated by the disturbing forces of the sun and moon.

It should be noted that this is a minimum, and any amount that is greater would still align with what we observe; the calculations do not contradict the idea that the entire globe is generally solid. They also allow us to visualize that large lakes or seas of melted material could exist within a shell 400 or 800 538 miles thick, as long as they are contained in a way that allows them to move with the shell, regardless of the rotational motion that may be affected by the gravitational forces of the sun and moon.

Central heat.—The hypothesis of internal fluidity calls for the more attentive consideration, as it has been found that the heat in mines augments in proportion as we descend. Observations have been made, not only on the temperature of the air in mines, but on that of the rocks, and on the water issuing from them. The mean rate of increase, calculated from results obtained in six of the deepest coal mines in Durham and Northumberland, is 1° Fahr. for a descent of forty-four English feet.747 A series of observations, made in several of the principal lead and silver mines in Saxony, gave 1° Fahr. for every sixty-five feet. In this case, the bulb of the thermometer was introduced into cavities purposely cut in the solid rock at depths varying from 200 to above 900 feet. But in other mines of the same country, it was necessary to descend thrice as far for each degree of temperature.748

Central heat.—The idea of internal fluidity deserves closer examination, as it's been observed that the heat in mines increases the deeper you go. Studies have been conducted not just on the air temperature in mines, but also on the temperature of the rocks and the water coming from them. The average rate of increase, calculated from results in six of the deepest coal mines in Durham and Northumberland, is 1° Fahrenheit for every forty-four English feet.747 A series of observations in several major lead and silver mines in Saxony showed an increase of 1° Fahrenheit for every sixty-five feet. In this case, the thermometer was placed into cavities specifically cut into the solid rock at depths ranging from 200 to over 900 feet. However, in other mines in the same region, it was necessary to descend three times the distance for each degree of temperature.748

A thermometer was fixed in the rock of the Dolcoath mine, in Cornwall, by Mr. Fox, at the great depth of 1380 feet, and frequently observed during eighteen months; the mean temperature was 68° Fahr., that of the surface being 50°, which gives 1° for every seventy-five feet.

A thermometer was installed in the rock of the Dolcoath mine in Cornwall by Mr. Fox at a depth of 1,380 feet, and it was regularly monitored for eighteen months. The average temperature was 68°F, while the surface temperature was 50°F, indicating a rise of 1°F for every seventy-five feet.

Kupffer, after an extensive comparison of the results in different countries, makes the increase 1° F. for about every thirty-seven English feet.749 M. Cordier announces, as the result of his experiments and observations on the temperature of the interior of the earth, that the heat increases rapidly with the depth; but the increase does not follow the same law over the whole earth, being twice or three times as much in one country as in another, and these differences are not in constant relation either with the latitudes or longitudes of places.750 He is of opinion, however, that the increase would not be overstated at 1° Cent. for every twenty-five metres, or about 1° F. for every forty-five feet.751 The experimental well bored at Grenelle, near Paris, gave about 1° F. for every sixty English feet, when they had reached a depth of 1312 feet.

Kupffer, after a detailed comparison of results from different countries, finds that the temperature increases by about 1°F for every thirty-seven English feet.749 M. Cordier reports that his experiments and observations on the Earth's interior temperature show that heat increases rapidly with depth; however, the rate of increase varies across the globe, being two to three times higher in some countries than in others, and these variations aren't consistently related to the latitudes or longitudes of the locations.750 He believes that it's reasonable to estimate the increase at about 1°C for every twenty-five meters, or roughly 1°F for every forty-five feet.751 The experimental well drilled at Grenelle, near Paris, showed an increase of about 1°F for every sixty English feet when they reached a depth of 1312 feet.

Some writers have endeavored to refer these phenomena (which, however discordant as to the ratio of increasing heat, appear all to point one way) to the condensation of air constantly descending from the surface into the mines. For the air under pressure would give out latent heat, on the same principle as it becomes colder when rarefied in the higher regions of the atmosphere. But, besides that the quantity of heat is greater than could be supposed to flow from this source, the argument has been answered in a satisfactory manner by Mr. Fox, who has shown, that in the mines of Cornwall the ascending have generally a higher 539 temperature than the descending aerial currents. The difference between them was found to vary from 9° to 17° F.; a proof that, instead of imparting heat, these currents actually carry off a large quantity from the mines.752

Some writers have tried to explain these phenomena (which, despite differing in the amount of increasing heat, all seem to indicate the same direction) as the result of air condensing as it continuously descends from the surface into the mines. Pressurized air would release latent heat, similar to how it cools down when it expands in the higher regions of the atmosphere. However, aside from the fact that the amount of heat is greater than what could be expected from this source, Mr. Fox has satisfactorily countered this argument by demonstrating that in the mines of Cornwall, the rising air currents generally have a higher temperature than the descending ones. The temperature difference was found to range from 9° to 17° F., showing that rather than providing heat, these currents actually remove a significant amount of heat from the mines. 539 752

If we adopt M. Cordier's estimate of 1° F. for every 45 feet of depth as the mean result, and assume, with the advocates of central fluidity, that the increasing temperature is continued downwards, we should reach the ordinary boiling point of water at about two miles below the surface, and at the depth of about twenty-four miles should arrive at the melting point of iron, a heat sufficient to fuse almost every known substance. The temperature of melted iron was estimated at 21,000° F., by Wedgwood; but his pyrometer gives, as is now demonstrated, very erroneous results. Professor Daniell ascertained that the point of fusion is 2,786° F.753

If we go with M. Cordier's estimate of 1° F. for every 45 feet of depth as the average, and assume, like those who support the idea of a fluid center, that the temperature keeps increasing as we go deeper, we would hit the standard boiling point of water at about two miles down and reach the melting point of iron at around twenty-four miles deep, which is hot enough to melt nearly every known substance. Wedgwood estimated the temperature of melted iron at 21,000° F., but his pyrometer has been proven to give very inaccurate results. Professor Daniell found that the melting point is actually 2,786° F.753

Fig. 92.Section of the earth.

Section of the earth, in which the breadth of the outer boundary line represents a thickness of 25 miles; the space between the circles, including the breadth of the lines, 200 miles.

Section of the earth, where the width of the outer boundary line represents a thickness of 25 miles; the distance between the circles, including the width of the lines, is 200 miles.

According to Mr. Daniell's scale, we ought to encounter the internal 540 melted matter before penetrating through a thickness represented by that of the outer circular line in the annexed diagram (fig. 92); whereas, if the other or less correct scale be adopted, we should meet with it at some point between the two circles; the space between them, together with the lines themselves, representing a crust of 200 miles in depth. In either case, we must be prepared to maintain that a temperature many times greater than that sufficient to melt the most refractory substances known to us, is sustained at the centre of the globe; while a comparatively thin crust, resting upon the fluid, remains unmelted; or is even, according to M. Cordier, increasing in thickness, by the continual addition of new internal layers solidified during the process of refrigeration.

According to Mr. Daniell's scale, we should expect to encounter the molten material before breaking through a thickness represented by the outer circular line in the attached diagram (fig. 92); however, if we use the other, less accurate scale, we would find it at some point between the two circles. The area between them, along with the lines themselves, represents a crust that's 200 miles deep. In either scenario, we need to acknowledge that a temperature far greater than what's needed to melt the most heat-resistant substances we know of is maintained at the Earth's center, while a relatively thin crust, sitting on top of the liquid, remains solid; or is even, according to M. Cordier, getting thicker due to the continuous addition of new internal layers that solidify during the cooling process.

The mathematical calculations of Fourier, on the passage of heat through conducting bodies, have been since appealed to in support of these views; for he has shown that it is compatible with theory that the present temperature of the surface might coexist with an intense heat at a certain depth below. But his reasoning seems to be confined to the conduction of heat through solid bodies; and the conditions of the problem are wholly altered when we reason about a fluid nucleus, as we must do if it be assumed that the heat augments from the surface to the interior, according to the rate observed in mines. For when the heat of the lower portion of a fluid is increased, a circulation begins throughout the mass, by the ascent of hotter, and the descent of colder currents. And this circulation, which is quite distinct from the mode in which heat is propagated through solid bodies, must evidently occur in the supposed central ocean, if the laws of fluids and of heat are the same there as upon the surface.

The mathematical calculations by Fourier on how heat moves through conducting materials have been used to support these ideas. He demonstrated that it's possible for the current surface temperature to exist alongside intense heat at a certain depth below. However, his reasoning seems limited to heat conduction in solid materials, and the situation changes entirely when we discuss a fluid core, especially if we assume that heat increases from the surface to the interior, like what we observe in mines. When the heat increases in the lower part of a fluid, a circulation starts throughout the mass, with hotter currents rising and colder ones sinking. This circulation, which is very different from how heat spreads through solid bodies, would clearly happen in the assumed central ocean, as long as the principles of fluids and heat apply there just like they do at the surface.

In Mr. Daniell's experiments for obtaining a measure of the heat of bodies at their point of fusion, he invariably found that it was impossible to raise the heat of a large crucible of melted iron, gold, or silver, a single degree beyond the melting point, so long as a bar of the respective metals was kept immersed in the fluid portions. So in regard to other substances, however great the quantities fused, their temperature could not be raised while any solid pieces immersed in them remained unmelted; every accession of heat being instantly absorbed during their liquefaction. These results are, in fact, no more than the extension of a principle previously established, that so long as a fragment of ice remains in water, we cannot raise the temperature of the water above 32° F.

In Mr. Daniell's experiments to measure the heat of materials at their melting point, he consistently found that it was impossible to increase the temperature of a large crucible of melted iron, gold, or silver by even a single degree above the melting point, as long as a bar of the respective metals was kept submerged in the liquid. Similarly, for other substances, no matter how large the quantities melted, their temperature couldn’t be raised as long as any solid pieces remained unmelted; every bit of heat added was instantly absorbed during their melting. These findings really just extend a principle already established: as long as a piece of ice is in water, we can't raise the water's temperature above 32° F.

If, then, the heat of the earth's centre amount to 450,000° F., as M. Cordier deems highly probable, that is to say, about twenty times the heat of melted iron, even according to Wedgwood's scale, and upwards of 160 times according to the improved pyrometer, it is clear that the upper parts of the fluid mass could not long have a temperature only just sufficient to melt rocks. There must be a continual tendency towards a uniform heat; and until this were accomplished, by the interchange of portions of fluid of different densities, the surface could not 541 begin to consolidate. Nor, on the hypothesis of primitive fluidity, can we conceive any crust to have been formed until the whole planet had cooled down to about the temperature of incipient fusion.

If the heat at the earth's center is around 450,000°F, as M. Cordier believes is very likely—about twenty times the heat of molten iron on Wedgwood's scale, and more than 160 times according to the improved pyrometer—it's obvious that the upper parts of the fluid mass couldn't maintain a temperature just enough to melt rocks for long. There must be a constant movement toward an even heat; until this is achieved through the mixing of fluid sections with different densities, the surface couldn't 541 start to solidify. Also, based on the idea of a primary fluid state, we can't imagine any crust forming until the whole planet had cooled down to about the temperature where melting begins.

It cannot be objected that hydrostatic pressure would prevent a tendency to equalization of temperature; for, as far as observations have yet been made, it is found that the waters of deep lakes and seas are governed by the same laws as a shallow pool; and no experiments indicate that solids resist fusion under high pressure. The arguments, indeed, now controverted, always proceed on the admission that the internal nucleus is in a state of fusion.

It can't be argued that hydrostatic pressure would stop the temperature from equalizing; because, based on current observations, the waters of deep lakes and seas follow the same principles as those of a shallow pool. Furthermore, no experiments have shown that solids resist melting under high pressure. The arguments currently disputed always assume that the internal core is molten.

It may be said that we may stand upon the hardened surface of a lava-current while it is still in motion,—nay, may descend into the crater of Vesuvius after an eruption, and stand on the scoriæ while every crevice shows that the rock is red-hot two or three feet below us; and at a somewhat greater depth, all is, perhaps, in a state of fusion. May not, then, a much more intense heat be expected at the depth of several hundred yards, or miles? The answer is,—that until a great quantity of heat has been given off, either by the emission of lava, or in a latent form by the evolution of steam and gas, the melted matter continues to boil in the crater of a volcano. But ebullition ceases when there is no longer a sufficient supply of heat from below, and then a crust of lava may form on the top, and showers of scoriæ may then descend upon the surface, and remain unmelted. If the internal heat be raised again, ebullition will recommence, and soon fuse the superficial crust. So in the case of the moving current, we may safely assume that no part of the liquid beneath the hardened surface is much above the temperature sufficient to retain it in a state of fluidity.

It can be said that we can stand on the hardened surface of a lava flow while it's still moving—actually, we can even go down into the crater of Vesuvius after an eruption and stand on the cinders while every crack shows that the rock is red-hot just a couple of feet below us; and at a slightly greater depth, everything is probably molten. So, can we expect a much hotter temperature at depths of several hundred yards or miles? The answer is that until a lot of heat has been released, either through lava flow or in a latent form by steam and gas escaping, the molten material keeps boiling in a volcano's crater. But boiling stops when there's no longer a sufficient supply of heat from below, and then a crust of lava can form on top, allowing showers of cinders to fall on the surface and stay unmelted. If the internal heat increases again, boiling will start up once more, quickly melting the top crust. Thus, in the case of the moving lava current, we can safely assume that the liquid beneath the hardened surface is only just above the temperature needed to keep it fluid.

It may assist us in forming a clearer view of the doctrine now controverted, if we consider what would happen were a globe of homogeneous composition placed under circumstances analogous, in regard to the distribution of heat, to those above stated. If the whole planet, for example, were composed of water covered with a spheroidal crust of ice fifty miles thick, and with an interior ocean having a central heat about two hundred times that of the melting point of ice, or 6400° F.; and if, between the surface and the centre, there was every intermediate degree of temperature between that of melting ice and that of the central nucleus—could such a state of things last for a moment? If it must be conceded, in this case, that the whole spheroid would be instantly in a state of violent ebullition, that the ice (instead of being strengthened annually by new internal layers) would soon melt, and form part of an atmosphere of steam—on what principle can it he maintained that analogous effects would not follow, in regard to the earth, under the conditions assumed in the theory of central heat?754

It might help us to get a clearer understanding of the current debated doctrine if we think about what would happen if a globe made of the same material was placed in conditions similar to those mentioned above, in terms of how heat is distributed. For example, if the whole planet was made of water covered by a spherical crust of ice fifty miles thick, with an interior ocean that had a core temperature about two hundred times that of the melting point of ice, or 6400° F.; and if, between the surface and the center, there was every possible temperature between that of melting ice and that of the central core—could such a situation last even for a moment? If we have to agree that in this case, the whole sphere would immediately be in a state of violent boiling, that the ice (instead of getting stronger each year with new internal layers) would soon melt and contribute to a steam atmosphere—on what grounds can it be argued that similar outcomes wouldn’t occur regarding the Earth, under the conditions proposed in the theory of central heat?754

542M. Cordier admits that there must be tides in the internal melted ocean; but their effect, he says, has become feeble, although originally, when the fluidity of the globe was perfect, "the rise and fall of these ancient land tides could not have been less than from thirteen to sixteen feet." Now, granting for a moment, that these tides have become so feeble as to be incapable of causing the fissured shell of the earth to be first uplifted and then depressed every six hours, still may we not ask whether, during eruptions, the lava, which is supposed to communicate with a great central ocean, would not rise and fall sensibly in a crater such as Stromboli, where there is always melted matter in a state of ebullition?

542M. Cordier acknowledges that there must be tides in the melted interior ocean, but he claims their impact has weakened. He suggests that initially, when the Earth's fluidity was complete, "the rise and fall of these ancient land tides could not have been less than thirteen to sixteen feet." Now, even if we assume these tides have weakened to the point where they can't lift and lower the Earth's cracked surface every six hours, we can still question whether, during eruptions, the lava—believed to connect with a vast central ocean—might not noticeably rise and fall in a crater like Stromboli, where molten material is continuously bubbling.

Whether chemical changes may produce volcanic heat.—Having now explained the reasons which have induced me to question the hypothesis of central heat as the primary source of volcanic action, it remains to consider what has been termed the chemical theory of volcanoes. It is well known that many, perhaps all, of the substances of which the earth is composed are continually undergoing chemical changes. To what depth these processes may be continued downwards must, in a great degree, be matter of conjecture; but there is no reason to suspect that, if we could descend to a great distance from the surface, we should find elementary substances differing essentially from those with which we are acquainted.

Whether chemical changes may produce volcanic heat.—Having explained why I question the idea of central heat as the main source of volcanic activity, we now need to look at what's called the chemical theory of volcanoes. It's well known that many, possibly all, of the materials that make up the Earth are constantly going through chemical changes. How deep these processes can go is mostly a matter of guesswork; however, there’s no reason to believe that if we could dig deep below the surface, we would find basic elements that are fundamentally different from what we know.

All the solid, fluid, and gaseous bodies known to us consist of a very small number of these elementary substances variously combined: the total number of elements at present known is less than sixty; and not half of these enter into the composition of the more abundant inorganic productions. Some portions of such compounds are daily undergoing decomposition, and their constituent parts being set free are passing into new combinations. These processes are by no means confined to minerals at the earth's surface, and are very often accompanied by the evolution of heat, which is intense in proportion to the rapidity of the combinations. At the same time there is a development of electricity.

All the solid, liquid, and gas substances we know consist of a very small number of these basic elements combined in different ways: currently, the total number of known elements is less than sixty, and not even half of these are part of the more common inorganic materials. Some parts of these compounds are breaking down every day, and their components are being released and forming new combinations. These processes aren't limited to minerals on the Earth's surface and often happen alongside the release of heat, which is more intense based on how quickly the combinations occur. At the same time, there's also a generation of electricity.

The spontaneous combustion of beds of bituminous shale, and of refuse coal thrown out of mines, is generally due to the decomposition of pyrites; and it is the contact of air and water which brings about the change. Heat results from the oxidation of the sulphur and iron, though on what principle heat is generated, when two or more bodies having a strong affinity for each other unite suddenly, is wholly unexplained.

The spontaneous combustion of piles of bituminous shale and waste coal discarded from mines is usually caused by the breakdown of pyrites. It's the interaction of air and water that triggers this change. Heat is produced from the oxidation of sulfur and iron, although the exact principle of how heat is generated when two or more substances that have a strong attraction to each other come together suddenly remains completely unexplained.

Electricity a source of volcanic heat.—It has already been stated, that chemical changes develop electricity; which, in its turn, becomes a powerful disturbing cause. As a chemical agent, says Davy, its silent and slow operation in the economy of nature is much more important than its grand and impressive operation in lightning and thunder. It may be considered, not only as directly producing an infinite variety of 543 changes, but as influencing almost all which take place; it would seem, indeed, that chemical attraction itself is only a peculiar form of the exhibition of electrical attraction.755

Electricity as a source of volcanic heat.—It has already been mentioned that chemical changes produce electricity, which in turn acts as a powerful disruptive force. As a chemical agent, Davy explains, its quiet and gradual impact on nature is far more significant than its dramatic display during lightning and thunder. It can be seen as not only directly creating an endless variety of changes but also influencing nearly all that happens; it appears that chemical attraction itself is merely a specific form of electrical attraction.755

Now that it has been demonstrated that magnetism and electricity are always associated, and are perhaps only different conditions of the same power, the phenomena of terrestrial magnetism have become of no ordinary interest to the geologist. Soon after the first great discoveries of Oersted in electro-magnetism, Ampère suggested that all the phenomena of the magnetic needle might be explained by supposing currents of electricity to circulate constantly in the shell of the globe in directions parallel to the magnetic equator. This theory has acquired additional consistency the farther we have advanced in science; and according to the experiments of Mr. Fox, on the electro-magnetic properties of metalliferous veins, some trace of electric currents seems to have been detected in the interior of the earth.756

Now that it's been shown that magnetism and electricity always go hand in hand and are probably just different forms of the same force, the phenomena of Earth's magnetism have become particularly interesting to geologists. Shortly after Oersted's groundbreaking discoveries in electromagnetism, Ampère proposed that all the behaviors of the magnetic needle could be explained by imagining electric currents circulating continuously in the Earth's shell, flowing parallel to the magnetic equator. This theory has gained more support as our scientific understanding has progressed; and according to experiments by Mr. Fox on the electromagnetic properties of mineral veins, some evidence of electric currents seems to have been found inside the Earth.756

Some philosophers ascribe these currents to the chemical action going on in the superficial parts of the globe to which air and water have the readiest access; while others refer them, in part at least, to thermo-electricity excited by the solar rays on the surface of the earth during its rotation; successive parts of the atmosphere, land, and sea being exposed to the influence of the sun, and then cooled again in the night. That this idea is not a mere speculation, is proved by the correspondence of the diurnal variations of the magnet with the apparent motion of the sun; and by the greater amount of variation in summer than in winter, and during the day than in the night. M. de la Rive, although conceding that such minor variations of the needle may be due to thermo-electricity, contends that the general phenomena of terrestrial magnetism must be attributed to currents far more intense; which, though liable to secular fluctuations, act with much greater constancy and regularity than the causes which produce the diurnal variations.757 The remark seems just; yet it is difficult to assign limits to the accumulated influence even of a very feeble force constantly acting on the whole surface of the earth. This subject, however, must evidently remain obscure, until we become acquainted with the causes which give a determinate direction to the supposed electric currents. Already the experiments of Faraday on the rotation of magnets have led him to speculate on the manner in which the earth, when once it had become magnetic, might produce electric currents within itself, in consequence of its diurnal rotation.758 We have seen also in a former chapter (p. 129) that the recent observations of Schwabe, 1852, have led Col. Sabine to the discovery of a connection between certain periodical changes, which take place in the spots on the sun, and a certain cycle of variations in terrestrial magnetism. These seem to point to the existence of a solar 544 magnetic period, and suggest the idea of the sun's magnetism exerting an influence on the mass of our planet.

Some philosophers attribute these currents to the chemical reactions occurring in the surface areas of the Earth that are most accessible to air and water. Others link them, at least in part, to thermo-electricity triggered by solar rays on the Earth's surface during its rotation; different parts of the atmosphere, land, and ocean are exposed to the sun's influence and then cool down at night. This idea isn't just speculation; it's supported by the relationship between the daily variations of the magnetic field and the apparent movement of the sun, along with the greater variation seen in summer compared to winter and during the day versus at night. M. de la Rive, while acknowledging that these minor fluctuations of the needle might be due to thermo-electricity, argues that the broader phenomena of terrestrial magnetism should be attributed to much stronger currents, which, although subject to long-term fluctuations, behave with greater consistency and regularity than the factors causing daily variations.757 This observation seems valid; however, it is challenging to establish limits on the combined effect of a very weak force that acts constantly on the entire surface of the Earth. This topic will likely remain unclear until we understand the factors that provide a specific direction to the supposed electric currents. Faraday's experiments with rotating magnets have led him to consider how the Earth, once it became magnetic, could generate electric currents within itself due to its daily rotation.758 We've also seen in a previous chapter (p. 129) that recent observations by Schwabe in 1852 prompted Col. Sabine to find a connection between certain periodic changes in solar spots and a cycle of variations in terrestrial magnetism. These findings seem to indicate a solar magnetic cycle and suggest that the sun's magnetism might affect the mass of our planet.

In regard to thermo-electricity, I may remark, that it may be generated by great inequalities of temperature, arising from a partial distribution of volcanic heat. Wherever, for example, masses of rock occur of great horizontal extent, and of considerable depth, which are at one point in a state of fusion (as beneath some active volcano); at another, red-hot; and at a third, comparatively cold—strong thermo-electric action may be excited.

In terms of thermo-electricity, I would like to point out that it can be created by significant temperature differences caused by uneven volcanic heat distribution. For instance, wherever there are large, widespread masses of rock that are deep underground, some of which may be molten (like under an active volcano), while others are red-hot, and some are relatively cold—intense thermo-electric activity can be generated.

Some, perhaps, may object, that this is reasoning in a circle; first to introduce electricity as one of the primary causes of volcanic heat, and then to derive the same heat from thermo-electric currents. But there must, in truth, be much reciprocal action between the agents now under consideration; and it is very difficult to decide which should be regarded as the prime mover, or to see where the train of changes, once begun, would terminate. Whether subterranean electric currents if once excited might sometimes possess the decomposing power of the voltaic pile, is a question not perhaps easily answered in the present state of science; but such a power, if developed, would at once supply us with a never-failing source of chemical action from which volcanic heat might be derived.

Some might argue that this is circular reasoning; first, introducing electricity as one of the main causes of volcanic heat, and then deriving that heat from thermo-electric currents. However, there has to be a lot of interaction between the factors we are looking at, and it’s quite challenging to determine which should be seen as the primary cause, or to understand where the sequence of changes might lead. Whether underground electric currents, once triggered, could sometimes have the same decomposing effect as a voltaic pile is a question that’s not easily answered given our current scientific knowledge; but if such a power were developed, it could give us a constant source of chemical activity from which volcanic heat could emerge.

Recapitulation.—Before entering, in the next chapter, still farther into the inquiry, how far the phenomena of volcanoes and earthquakes accord with the hypothesis of a continued generation of heat by chemical action, it may be desirable to recapitulate, in a few words, the conclusions already obtained.

Recapitulation.—Before moving into the next chapter to explore further how the events of volcanoes and earthquakes align with the idea of ongoing heat generation through chemical reactions, it may be useful to briefly summarize the conclusions we've already reached.

1st. The primary causes of the volcano and the earthquake are, to a great extent, the same, and must be connected with the passage of heat from the interior to the surface.

1st. The main causes of volcanoes and earthquakes are, to a large extent, the same and are linked to the transfer of heat from the inside to the surface.

2dly. This heat has been referred, by many, to a supposed state of igneous fusion of the central parts of the planet when it was first created, of which a part still remains in the interior, but is always diminishing in intensity.

2dly. Many have attributed this heat to a supposed state of molten rock in the core of the planet when it was first formed, some of which still exists in the interior, though it is continuously decreasing in intensity.

3dly. The spheroidal figure of the earth, adduced in support of this theory, does not of necessity imply a universal and simultaneous fluidity, in the beginning; for supposing the original figure of our planet had been strictly spherical—which, however, is a gratuitous assumption, resting on no established analogy—still the statical figure must have been assumed, if sufficient time be allowed, by the gradual operation of the centrifugal force, acting on the materials brought successively within its action by aqueous and igneous causes.

3rd. The round shape of the earth, used to support this theory, doesn’t necessarily mean that everything was fluid and moving at the same time in the beginning. Even if we assume our planet originally had a perfect spherical shape—which, by the way, is an unfounded assumption without any solid evidence—it’s still possible that this stable shape could have formed over time due to centrifugal force acting on materials that were gradually affected by water and fire.

4thly. It appears, from experiment, that the heat in mines increases progressively with their depth; and if the ratio of increase be continued uniformly from the surface to the interior, the whole globe, with the exception of a small external shell, must be fluid, and the central parts must have a temperature many times higher than that of melted iron.

4thly. Experiments show that the heat in mines increases steadily as you go deeper. If this rate of increase continues consistently from the surface to the interior, then the entire globe, except for a small outer layer, must be in a liquid state, and the core must be much hotter than melted iron.

5thly. But the theory adopted by M. Cordier and others, which 545 maintains the actual existence of such a state of things, seems wholly inconsistent with the laws which regulate the circulation of heat through fluid bodies. For, if the central heat were as intense as is represented, there must be a circulation of currents, tending to equalize the temperature of the resulting fluids, and the solid crust itself would be melted.

5thly. However, the theory put forward by M. Cordier and others, which 545 claims that such a state of affairs actually exists, appears entirely inconsistent with the laws governing the flow of heat through liquids. If the central heat were as intense as described, there would have to be a circulation of currents that aim to balance the temperature of the resulting fluids, and the solid crust would end up melting.

6thly. Instead of an original central heat, we may, perhaps, refer the heat of the interior to chemical changes constantly going on in the earth's crust; for the general effect of chemical combination is the evolution of heat and electricity, which in their turn become sources of new chemical changes.

6thly. Instead of having a primary source of heat, we might attribute the heat found in the earth's interior to the ongoing chemical reactions occurring in the earth's crust; because the overall effect of chemical reactions is the release of heat and electricity, which then serve as sources for new chemical reactions.


CHAPTER XXXII.

CAUSES OF EARTHQUAKES AND VOLCANOES—continued.

Review of the proofs of internal heat—Theory of an unoxidated metallic nucleus—Whether the decomposition of water may be a source of volcanic heat—Geysers of Iceland—Causes of earthquakes—Wavelike motion—Expansive power of liquid gases—Connection between the state of the atmosphere and earthquakes—Permanent upheaval and subsidence of land—Expansion of rocks by heat—The balance of dry land how preserved—Subsidence in excess—Conclusion.

Review of the evidence for internal heat—Theory of a non-oxidized metal core—Whether the breakdown of water could be a source of volcanic heat—Geysers of Iceland—Causes of earthquakes—Wave-like motion—Expanding power of liquid gases—Link between weather conditions and earthquakes—Ongoing rise and sinking of land—Expansion of rocks due to heat—How the balance of land is maintained—Excessive sinking—Conclusion.

When we reflect that the largest mountains are but insignificant protuberances upon the surface of the earth, and that these mountains are nevertheless composed of different parts which have been formed in succession, we may well feel surprise that the central fluidity of the planet should have been called in to account for volcanic phenomena. To suppose the entire globe to be in a state of igneous fusion, with the exception of a solid shell, not more than from thirty to one hundred miles thick, and to imagine that the central heat of this fluid spheroid exceeds by more than two hundred times that of liquid lava, is to introduce a force altogether disproportionate to the effects which it is required to explain.

When we think about how the tallest mountains are really just small bumps on the surface of the earth, and that these mountains consist of different layers that formed over time, it's surprising to consider why we've blamed the planet's molten core for volcanic activity. To believe that the whole globe is in a state of molten rock, except for a solid shell that's only about thirty to one hundred miles thick, and to assume that the heat at the center of this fluid sphere is over two hundred times hotter than liquid lava, is to suggest a power that is completely out of proportion to the effects it is supposed to explain.

The ordinary repose of the surface implies, on the contrary, an inertness in the internal mass which is truly wonderful. When we consider the combustible nature of the elements of the earth, so far as they are known to us,—the facility with which their compounds may be decomposed and made to enter into new combinations,—the quantity of heat which they evolve during these processes; when we recollect the expansive power of steam, and that water itself is composed of two gases which, by their union, produce intense heat; when we call to mind the number of explosive and detonating compounds which have been already discovered, we may be allowed to share the astonishment of Pliny, that a single 546 day should pass without a general conflagration:—"Excedit profectò omnia miracula, ullum diem fuisse quo non cuncta conflagrarent."759

The calm appearance of the surface suggests, on the other hand, a truly amazing stillness in the inner substance. When we think about how combustible the elements of the earth are, as far as we know—how easily their compounds can be broken down and reassemble into new combinations—and the amount of heat they release during these processes; when we remember the explosive power of steam, and that water itself is made up of two gases that produce intense heat when they combine; when we consider the many explosive and detonating compounds that have already been discovered, we can understand Pliny’s astonishment that a single day passes without a widespread fire: "Excedit profectò omnia miracula, ullum diem fuisse quo non cuncta conflagrarent." 546 759

The signs of internal heat observable on the surface of the earth do not necessarily indicate the permanent existence of subterranean heated masses, whether fluid or solid, by any means so vast as our continents and seas; yet how insignificant would these appear if distributed through an external shell of the globe one or two hundred miles in depth! The principal facts in proof of the accumulation of heat below the surface may be summed up in a few words. Several volcanoes are constantly in eruption, as Stromboli and Nicaragua; others are known to have been active for periods of 60, or even 150 years, as those of Sangay in Quito, Popocatepetl in Mexico, and the volcano of the Isle of Bourbon. Many craters emit hot vapors in the intervals between eruptions, and solfataras evolve incessantly the same gases as volcanoes. Steam of high temperature has continued for more than twenty centuries to issue from the "stufas," as the Italians call them; thermal springs abound not only in regions of earthquakes, but are found in almost all countries, however distant from active vents; and, lastly, the temperature in the mines of various parts of the world is found to increase in proportion as we descend.

The signs of internal heat visible on the Earth's surface don’t necessarily mean there are large underground heated areas, whether liquid or solid, as vast as our continents and oceans; yet, they would seem pretty small if spread out over a shell of the Earth that's one or two hundred miles deep! The main facts proving the buildup of heat below the surface can be summarized in a few points. Several volcanoes are constantly erupting, like Stromboli and Nicaragua; others have been active for periods of 60 or even 150 years, such as Sangay in Quito, Popocatepetl in Mexico, and the volcano on the Isle of Bourbon. Many craters release hot vapors between eruptions, and solfataras continuously emit the same gases as volcanoes. High-temperature steam has been coming out of the "stufas," as the Italians call them, for over twenty centuries; thermal springs are not only found in earthquake-prone areas but are also present in almost all countries, no matter how far they are from active vents; and finally, the temperature in mines around the world increases the deeper you go.

The diagram (fig. 93) in the next page, may convey some idea of the proportion which our continents and the ocean bear to the radius of the earth.760 If all the land were about as high as the Himalaya mountains, and the ocean everywhere as deep as the Pacific, the whole of both might be contained within a space expressed by the thickness of the line a b; and masses of nearly equal volume might be placed in the space marked by the line c d, in the interior. Seas of lava, therefore, of the size of the Mediterranean, or even of the Atlantic, would be as nothing if distributed through such an outer shell of the globe as is represented by the shaded portion of the figure a b c d. If throughout that space we imagine electro-chemical causes to be continually in operation, even of very feeble power, they might give rise to heat which, if accumulated at certain points, might melt or render red-hot entire mountains, or sustain the temperature of stufas and hot springs for ages.

The diagram (fig. 93) on the next page may give some idea of the proportion between our continents and the ocean compared to the radius of the earth.760 If all the land were about as high as the Himalayas, and the ocean as deep as the Pacific everywhere, both could fit within a space represented by the thickness of the line a b; and masses with nearly equal volume could be placed within the space marked by the line c d, inside. Seas of lava, therefore, the size of the Mediterranean or even the Atlantic, would be negligible if distributed throughout such an outer shell of the globe like the shaded area in figure a b c d. If we imagine that electro-chemical processes are constantly occurring in that space, even with very weak forces, they could generate heat that, if concentrated at certain points, might melt or heat entire mountains or maintain the temperature of stoves and hot springs for ages.

Theory of an unoxidated metallic nucleus.—When Sir H. Davy first discovered the metallic basis of the earths and alkalies, he threw out the idea that those metals might abound in an unoxidized state in the subterranean regions to which water must occasionally penetrate. Whenever this happened, gaseous matter would be set free, the metals would combine with the oxygen of the water, and sufficient heat might be evolved to melt the surrounding rocks. This hypothesis, although afterwards abandoned by its author, was at first very favorably received both by the chemist and the geologist: for silica, alumina, lime, soda, and oxide of iron,—substances of which lavas are principally composed,—would 547 all result from the contact of the inflammable metals alluded to with water. But whence this abundant store of unsaturated metals in the interior? It was assumed that, in the beginning of things, the nucleus of the earth was mainly composed of inflammable metals, and that oxidation went on with intense energy at first; till at length, when a superficial crust of oxides had been formed, the chemical action became more and more languid.

Theory of an unoxidized metallic nucleus.—When Sir H. Davy first discovered the metallic basis of the earth's compounds and alkalines, he suggested that these metals might exist in an unoxidized state in the underground areas where water occasionally penetrates. Whenever this occurred, gaseous substances would be released, the metals would combine with the oxygen in the water, and enough heat could be generated to melt the surrounding rocks. This idea, although later discarded by its originator, was initially very well-received by both chemists and geologists: because silica, alumina, lime, soda, and iron oxide—substances primarily found in lavas—would all result from the interaction between the flammable metals mentioned and water. But where did this rich supply of unsaturated metals in the Earth's interior come from? It was proposed that, at the beginning of time, the Earth’s nucleus was primarily made up of flammable metals, and that oxidation was very intense at first; until eventually, after a layer of oxides had formed on the surface, the chemical reactions slowed down significantly.

Fig. 93.>Centre of the earth.

Centre of the earth.

Center of the Earth.

This speculation, like all others respecting the primitive state of the earth's nucleus, rests unavoidably on arbitrary assumptions. But we 548 may fairly inquire whether any existing causes may have the power of deoxidating the earthy and alkaline compounds formed from time to time by the action of water upon the metallic bases. If so, and if the original crust or nucleus of the planet contained distributed through it here and there some partial stores of potassium, sodium, and other metallic bases, these might be oxidated and again deoxidated, so as to sustain for ages a permanent chemical action. Yet even then we should be unable to explain why such a continuous circle of operations, after having been kept up for thousands of years in one district, should entirely cease, and why another region, which had enjoyed a respite from volcanic action for one or many geological periods, should become a theatre for the development of subterranean heat.

This speculation, like all others about the early state of the earth's core, relies on arbitrary assumptions. But we 548 can reasonably ask whether any current processes have the ability to remove oxygen from the earthy and alkaline compounds created over time by water acting on metallic bases. If that's the case, and if the planet's original crust or core had scattered deposits of potassium, sodium, and other metallic bases, these could be oxidized and then deoxidized again, maintaining a constant chemical reaction for ages. Even so, we still wouldn't be able to explain why such a continuous cycle of processes, after being sustained for thousands of years in one area, would suddenly stop, or why another area, which had been free from volcanic activity for one or many geological periods, would become a site for underground heat development.

It is well known to chemists, that the metallization of oxides, the most difficult to reduce, may be effected by hydrogen brought into contact with them at a red heat; and it is more than probable that the production of potassium itself, in the common gun-barrel process, is due to the power of nascent hydrogen derived from the water which the hydrated oxide contains. According to the recent experiments, also, of Faraday, it would appear that every case of metallic reduction by voltaic agency, from saline solutions, in which water is present, is due to the secondary action of hydrogen upon the oxide; both of these being determined to the negative pole and then reacting upon one another.

It is well known among chemists that the reduction of oxides, which are the hardest to reduce, can be achieved by exposing them to hydrogen at high temperatures. It's likely that the production of potassium in the usual gun-barrel process comes from the nascent hydrogen that originates from the water contained in the hydrated oxide. Recent experiments by Faraday also suggest that in every instance of metallic reduction through electrical methods, where water is involved, the secondary action of hydrogen on the oxide is responsible; both the metal and the oxide are directed to the negative pole and then react with each other.

It is admitted that intense heat would be produced by the occasional contact of water with the metallic bases; and it is certain that, during the process of saturation, vast volumes of hydrogen must be evolved. The hydrogen, thus generated, might permeate the crust of the earth in different directions, and become stored up for ages in fissures and caverns, sometimes in a liquid form, under the necessary pressure. Whenever, at any subsequent period, in consequence of the changes effected by earthquakes in the shell of the earth, this gas happened to come in contact with metallic oxides at a high temperature, the reduction of these oxides might be the result.

It’s clear that intense heat would be generated when water occasionally contacts the metal bases; and it’s certain that, during the saturation process, large amounts of hydrogen must be released. The hydrogen produced could spread through the Earth's crust in various directions and become trapped for a long time in cracks and caves, sometimes in liquid form, under the right pressure. Whenever, at a later time, changes caused by earthquakes in the Earth's surface lead this gas to come into contact with metallic oxides at high temperatures, those oxides could be reduced as a result.

No theory seems at first more startling than that which represents water as affording an inexhaustible supply of fuel to the volcanic fires; yet is it by no means visionary. It is a fact that must not be overlooked, that while a great number of volcanoes are entirely submarine, the remainder occur for the most part in islands or maritime tracts. There are a few exceptions; but some of these, observes Dr. Daubeny, are near inland salt lakes, as in Central Tartary; while others form part of a train of volcanoes, the extremities of which are near the sea.

No theory seems more surprising at first than the idea that water provides an endless supply of fuel for volcanic fires; however, it’s not just fanciful thinking. It’s important to recognize that while many volcanoes are completely underwater, the rest mostly occur on islands or coastal areas. There are some exceptions, but Dr. Daubeny points out that some of these are close to inland salt lakes, like in Central Tartary, while others are part of a chain of volcanoes, with their ends near the ocean.

Sir H. Davy suggested that, when the sea is distant, as in the case of some of the South American volcanoes, they may still be supplied with water from subterranean lakes; since, according to Humboldt, large quantities of fish are often thrown out during eruptions.761 Mr. Dana also, in his valuable and original observations on the volcanoes of the 549 Sandwich Islands, reminds us of the prodigious volume of atmospheric water which must be absorbed into the interior of such large and lofty domes, composed as they are entirely of porous lava. To this source alone he refers the production of the steam by which the melted matter is propelled upwards, even to the summit of cones three miles in height.762

Sir H. Davy suggested that even when the sea is far away, as is the case with some South American volcanoes, they might still get water from underground lakes; because, according to Humboldt, large amounts of fish are often ejected during eruptions.761 Mr. Dana, in his valuable and original observations on the volcanoes of the 549Sandwich Islands, reminds us of the huge amount of atmospheric water that must be absorbed into the interior of such large and tall domes, which are entirely made of porous lava. He attributes the production of the steam that pushes the molten material upwards, even to the tops of cones that are three miles high, solely to this source.762

When treating of springs and overflowing wells, I have stated that porous rocks are percolated by fresh water to great depths, and that sea-water probably penetrates in the same manner through the rocks which form the bed of the ocean. But, besides this universal circulation in regions not far from the surface, it must be supposed that, wherever earthquakes prevail, much larger bodies of water will be forced by the pressure of the ocean into fissures at great depths, or swallowed up in chasms; in the same manner as on the land, towns, houses, cattle, and trees are sometimes engulfed. It will be remembered, that these chasms often close again after houses have fallen into them; and for the same reason, when water has penetrated to a mass of melted lava, the steam into which it is converted may often rush out at a different aperture from that by which the water entered.

When discussing springs and overflowing wells, I've mentioned that porous rocks are soaked by fresh water to considerable depths, and that seawater likely seeps in the same way through the rocks that make up the ocean floor. Besides this widespread circulation in areas not too deep, it's reasonable to assume that wherever earthquakes occur, large amounts of water will be pushed by ocean pressure into deep cracks or lost in chasms; similar to how, on land, towns, houses, livestock, and trees can sometimes be swallowed up. It's worth noting that these chasms often close again after structures have fallen into them; for the same reason, when water seeps into a mass of molten lava, the steam it turns into can often escape through a different opening than the one where the water entered.

The gases, it is said, exhaled from volcanoes, together with steam, are such as would result from the decomposition of salt water, and the fumes which escape from the Vesuvian lava have been observed to deposit common salt.763 The emission of free muriatic acid gas in great quantities is also thought by many to favor the theory of the decomposition of the salt contained in sea-water. It has been objected, however, that M. Boussingault did not meet with this gas in his examination of the elastic fluids evolved from the volcanoes of equatorial America; which only give out aqueous vapor (in very large quantity), carbonic acid gas, sulphurous acid gas, and sometimes fumes of sulphur.764 In reply, Dr. Daubeny has remarked, that muriatic acid may have ceased to be disengaged, because the volcanic action has become languid in equatorial America, and sea-water may no longer obtain admission.

The gases released from volcanoes, along with steam, are thought to be similar to what you'd get from breaking down salt water, and the fumes from Vesuvian lava have been seen to leave behind common salt.763 Many believe that the large amounts of free muriatic acid gas that are emitted support the idea of the decomposition of the salt found in sea water. However, some have pointed out that M. Boussingault did not detect this gas during his study of the gases released from volcanoes in equatorial America, which only produced a lot of water vapor, carbonic acid gas, sulfur dioxide, and sometimes sulfur fumes.764 In response, Dr. Daubeny noted that muriatic acid might not be released anymore because volcanic activity has slowed down in equatorial America, and sea water may not be entering the system like it used to.

M. Gay Lussac, while he avows his opinion that the decomposition of water contributes largely to volcanic action, called attention, nevertheless, to the supposed fact, that hydrogen had not been detected in a separate form among the gaseous products of volcanoes; nor can it, he says, be present; for, in that case, it would be inflamed in the air by the red-hot stones thrown out during an eruption. Dr. Davy, in his account of Graham Island, says, "I watched when the lightning was most vivid, and the eruption of the greatest degree of violence, to see if there was any inflammation occasioned by this natural electric spark—any indication of the presence of inflammable gas; but in vain."765

M. Gay Lussac, while expressing his belief that the breakdown of water plays a significant role in volcanic activity, pointed out that hydrogen has not been found separately among the gases produced by volcanoes; moreover, he states that it cannot be present because, if it were, it would ignite in the air due to the hot rocks expelled during an eruption. Dr. Davy, in his report on Graham Island, says, "I observed when the lightning was strongest and the eruption was most intense, to check for any ignition caused by this natural electric spark—any sign of flammable gas; but it was in vain."765

May not the hydrogen, Gay Lussac inquires, be combined with chlorine, and produce muriatic acid? for this gas has been observed to be evolved from Vesuvius—and the chlorine may have been derived from 550 sea salt; which was, in fact, extracted by simple washing from the Vesuvian lava of 1822, in the proportion of nine per cent.766 But it was answered, that Sir H. Davy's experiments had shown, that hydrogen is not combustible when mixed with muriatic acid gas; so that if muriatic gas was evolved in large quantities, the hydrogen might be present without inflammation.767 M. Abich, on the other hand, assures us, "that although it be true that vapor illuminated by incandescent lava has often been mistaken for flame," yet he clearly detected in the eruption of Vesuvius in 1834 the flame of hydrogen.768

May not hydrogen, Gay Lussac asks, be combined with chlorine and produce muriatic acid? This gas has been seen coming from Vesuvius—and the chlorine might have come from sea salt; which was actually extracted by simply washing from the Vesuvian lava of 1822, making up about nine percent.550766 But it was replied that Sir H. Davy's experiments showed that hydrogen is not flammable when mixed with muriatic acid gas; so if muriatic gas was produced in large amounts, hydrogen might be present without catching fire.767 M. Abich, on the other hand, assures us, "that although it's true that vapor illuminated by incandescent lava has often been mistaken for flame," he clearly identified the flame of hydrogen during the eruption of Vesuvius in 1834.768

M. Gay Lussac, in the memoir just alluded to, expressed doubt as to the presence of sulphurous acid; but the abundant disengagement of this gas during eruptions has been since ascertained: and thus all difficulty in regard to the general absence of hydrogen in an inflammable state is removed; for, as Dr. Daubeny suggests, the hydrogen of decomposed water may unite with sulphur to form sulphuretted hydrogen gas, and this gas will then be mingled with the sulphurous acid as it rises to the crater. It is shown by experiment, that these gases mutually decompose each other when mixed where steam is present; the hydrogen of the one immediately uniting with the oxygen of the other to form water, while the excess of sulphurous acid alone escapes into the atmosphere. Sulphur is at the same time precipitated.

M. Gay Lussac, in the referenced memoir, expressed doubts about the existence of sulfurous acid; however, the significant release of this gas during eruptions has since been confirmed. This clears up any confusion about the general lack of hydrogen in a flammable state. As Dr. Daubeny points out, the hydrogen from decomposed water can combine with sulfur to create hydrogen sulfide gas, which then mixes with the sulfurous acid as it rises to the crater. Experiments show that these gases break down each other when mixed in the presence of steam; the hydrogen from one gas quickly combines with the oxygen from the other to form water, while the excess sulfurous acid escapes into the atmosphere. Sulfur is also precipitated at the same time.

This explanation is sufficient; but it may also be observed that the flame of hydrogen would rarely be visible during an eruption; as that gas, when inflamed in a pure state, burns with a very faint blue flame, which even in the night could hardly be perceptible by the side of redhot and incandescent cinders. Its immediate, conversion into water when inflamed in the atmosphere, might also account for its not appearing in a separate form.

This explanation is enough; however, it's also worth noting that the flame of hydrogen would rarely be visible during an eruption. This gas, when burned in its pure form, produces a very faint blue flame, which even at night could barely be seen next to the glowing red hot cinders. Its quick conversion into water when ignited in the atmosphere could also explain why it doesn’t appear separately.

Dr. Daubeny is of opinion that water containing atmospheric air may descend from the surface of the earth to the volcanic foci, and that the same process of combustion by which water is decomposed may deprive such subterranean air of its oxygen. In this manner he explains the great quantities of nitrogen evolved from volcanic vents and thermal waters, and the fact that air disengaged from the earth in volcanic regions is either wholly or in part deprived of its oxygen.

Dr. Daubeny believes that water mixed with air from the atmosphere can travel down from the earth's surface to volcanic hotspots, and that the same combustion process that breaks down water may also strip the subterranean air of its oxygen. He uses this to explain the large amounts of nitrogen released from volcanic vents and hot springs, as well as the observation that the air released from the earth in volcanic areas is either completely or partially lacking in oxygen.

Sir H. Davy, in his memoir on the "Phenomena of Volcanoes," remarks, that there was every reason to suppose in Vesuvius the existence of a descending current of air; and he imagined that subterranean cavities which threw out large volumes of steam during the eruption, might afterwards, in the quiet state of the volcano, become filled with atmospheric air.769 The presence of ammoniacal salts in volcanic emanations, and of ammonia (which is in part composed of nitrogen) in lava, favors greatly the notion of air as well as water being deoxidated in the interior of the earth.770

Sir H. Davy, in his paper on the "Phenomena of Volcanoes," points out that there is ample reason to believe that Vesuvius has a descending current of air. He speculated that underground cavities, which released large amounts of steam during eruptions, might eventually, when the volcano is calm, become filled with atmospheric air.769 The presence of ammonium salts in volcanic emissions, along with ammonia (which contains nitrogen) in lava, strongly supports the idea that both air and water are being deoxidized inside the earth.770

551 It has been alleged by Professor Bischoff that the slight specific gravity of the metals of the alkalies is fatal to Davy's hypothesis, for if the mean density of the earth, as determined by astronomers, surpass that of all kinds of rocks, these metals cannot exist, at least not in great quantities in the interior of the earth.771 But Dr. Daubeny has shown, that if we take the united specific gravity of potassium, sodium, silicon, iron, and all the materials which, when united with oxygen, constitute ordinary lava, and then compare their weight with lava of equal bulk, the difference is not very material, the specific gravity of the lava only exceeding by about one-fourth that of the unoxidized metals. Besides, at great depths, the metallic bases of the earths and alkalies may very probably be rendered heavier by pressure.772 Nor is it fair to embarrass the chemical theory of volcanoes with a doctrine so purely gratuitous, as that which supposes the entire nucleus of the planet to have been at first composed of unoxidated metals.

551 Professor Bischoff claims that the low specific gravity of alkaline metals undermines Davy's hypothesis. If the average density of the earth, as determined by astronomers, exceeds that of all types of rocks, then these metals cannot exist, at least not in significant amounts, in the earth's interior.771 However, Dr. Daubeny has demonstrated that if we consider the combined specific gravity of potassium, sodium, silicon, iron, and all the materials that, when combined with oxygen, make up ordinary lava, and then compare their weight with an equal volume of lava, the difference is not substantial. The specific gravity of lava is only about one-fourth greater than that of the unoxidized metals. Additionally, at great depths, the metallic bases of the earth and alkali metals could likely become heavier due to pressure.772 It's also unfair to complicate the chemical theory of volcanoes with a completely unfounded idea that suggests the planet's entire core was originally made up of unoxidized metals.

Professor Bunsen of Marburg, after analyzing the gases which escape from the volcanic fumeroles and solfataras of Iceland, and after calculating the quantity of hydrogen evolved between two eruptions, affirms, in contradiction of opinions previously entertained, that the hydrogen bears a perfect relation in quantity to the magnitude of the streams of lava, assuming the fusion of these last to have been the result of the heat evolved during the oxidation of alkaline and earthy metals, and this to have been brought about by the decomposition of water. Yet after having thus succeeded in removing the principal objection once so triumphantly urged against Davy's hypothesis, Bunsen concludes by declaring that the hydrogen evolved in volcanic regions cannot have been generated by the decomposition of water coming in contact with alkaline and earthy metallic bases. For, says the Professor, this process presupposes the prevalence of a temperature in which carbonic acid cannot exist in contact with hydrogen without suffering a partial reduction to carbonic oxide; "and not a trace of carbonic oxide is ever found in volcanic exhalations."773 At the same time it will be seen, by consulting the able memoirs of the Marburg chemist, that he supposes many energetic kinds of chemical action to be continually going on in the interior of the earth, capable of causing the disengagement of hydrogen; and there can be no doubt that this gas may be a source of innumerable new changes, capable of producing the local development of internal heat.

Professor Bunsen from Marburg, after studying the gases that escape from the volcanic fumeroles and solfataras in Iceland, and calculating the amount of hydrogen released between two eruptions, claims, contrary to earlier beliefs, that the hydrogen is perfectly proportional in quantity to the size of the lava flows, assuming that the melting of the lava results from the heat produced during the oxidation of alkaline and earthy metals, which is caused by the breakdown of water. However, after successfully addressing the main objection that was previously used against Davy's hypothesis, Bunsen concludes by stating that the hydrogen released in volcanic areas cannot have been created by the breakdown of water interacting with alkaline and earthy metal bases. For, the Professor states, this process assumes a temperature where carbonic acid cannot exist alongside hydrogen without undergoing partial reduction to carbonic oxide; "and not a trace of carbonic oxide is ever found in volcanic emissions."773 At the same time, it will be noted by reviewing the insightful papers of the Marburg chemist that he believes many strong types of chemical reactions are continuously happening within the Earth, capable of causing the release of hydrogen; and there is no doubt that this gas can lead to countless new changes, capable of producing localized internal heat.

Cause of volcanic eruptions.—The most probable causes of a volcanic outburst at the surface have been in a great degree anticipated in the preceding speculations on the liquefaction of rocks and the generation of gases. When a minute hole is bored in a tube filled with gas condensed into a liquid, the whole becomes instantly aeriform, or, as some writers have expressed it, "flashes into vapor," and often bursts the tube. Such 552 an experiment may represent the mode in which gaseous matter may rush through a rent in the rocks, and continue to escape for days or weeks through a small orifice, with an explosive power sufficient to reduce every substance which opposes its passage into small fragments or even dust. Lava may be propelled upwards at the same time, and ejected in the form of scoriæ. In some places, where the fluid lava lies at the bottom of a deep fissure, communicating on the one hand with the surface, and on the other with a cavern in which a considerable body of vapor has been formed, there may be an efflux of lava, followed by the escape of gas. Eruptions often commence and close with the discharge of vapor; and, when this is the case, the next outburst may be expected to take place by the same vent, for the concluding evolution of elastic fluids will keep open the duct, and leave it unobstructed.

Cause of volcanic eruptions.—The likely causes of a volcanic eruption at the surface have largely been anticipated in the earlier discussions about the melting of rocks and the formation of gases. When a tiny hole is made in a tube filled with gas that’s been turned into a liquid, it instantly becomes gas again, or, as some writers have put it, "flashes into vapor," and often bursts the tube. Such 552 an experiment may illustrate how gas can rush through a crack in the rocks and continue to escape for days or weeks through a small opening, with enough explosive force to break down anything in its way into small pieces or even dust. Lava can also be pushed upwards at the same time and expelled as scoria. In some areas, where the molten lava sits at the bottom of a deep crack that connects to the surface on one side and a cavern with a significant amount of vapor on the other, there can be an outflow of lava followed by gas release. Eruptions often start and end with the release of vapor; when this happens, you can expect the next outburst to occur through the same opening since the final release of gases will keep the channel open and clear.

The breaking out of lava from the side or base of a lofty cone, rather than from the summit, may be attributed to the hydrostatic pressure to which the flanks of the mountain are exposed, when the column of lava has risen to a great height. Or if, before it has reached the top, there should happen to be any stoppage in the main duct, the upward pressure of the ascending column of gas and lava may burst a lateral opening.

The flow of lava from the side or base of a tall cone, rather than from the top, can be explained by the hydrostatic pressure that the sides of the mountain experience when the lava column has risen significantly. Or if there is a blockage in the main conduit before it reaches the summit, the upward pressure from the rising gas and lava can create a lateral opening.

In the case however of Mount Loa, in the Sandwich Islands, there appears to be a singular want of connection or sympathy between the eruptions of the central and the great lateral vent. The great volcanic cone alluded to rises to the height of 13,760 feet above the level of the sea, having a crater at its summit, from which powerful streams of lava have flowed in recent times, and having another still larger crater, called Kilauea, on its southeastern slope, about 4000 feet above the sea. This lateral cavity resembles a huge quarry cut in the mountain's side, being about 1000 feet deep when in its ordinary state. It is seven miles and a half in circuit, and scattered over its bottom, at different levels, are lakes and pools of lava, always in a state of ebullition. The liquid in one of these will sometimes sink 100 or 150 feet, while it is overflowing in another at a higher elevation, there being, it should seem, no communication between them. In like manner, lava overflows in the summit crater of Mount Loa, nearly 14,000 feet high, while the great lateral cauldron just alluded to (of Kilauea) continues as tranquil as usual, affording no relief to any part of the gases or melted matter which are forcing their way upwards in the centre of the mountain. "How," asks Mr. Dana, "if there were any subterranean channel connecting the two great vents, could this want of sympathy exist? How, according to the laws of hydrostatic pressure, can a column of fluid stand 10,000 feet higher in one leg of the siphon than in the other?" The eruptions, he observes, are not paroxysmal; on the contrary, the lava rises slowly and gradually to the summit of the lofty cone, and then escapes there without any commotion manifesting itself in Kilauea, a gulf always open on the flanks of the same mountain. One conclusion, he says, is certain, namely, that volcanoes are no safety valves as they have been called; for here two independent and apparently isolated centres of volcanic activity, only 553 sixteen miles distant from each other, are sustained in one and the same cone.774

In the case of Mount Loa in the Hawaiian Islands, there seems to be a strange lack of connection or coordination between the eruptions of the central vent and the large lateral vent. The huge volcanic cone rises to an elevation of 13,760 feet above sea level, featuring a crater at its summit from which powerful streams of lava have flowed in recent times. There’s also a much larger crater called Kilauea on its southeastern slope, about 4,000 feet above sea level. This lateral cavity looks like a massive quarry carved into the mountain's side, approximately 1,000 feet deep in its typical state. It has a circumference of seven and a half miles, and scattered across its bottom at various levels are lakes and pools of lava, always bubbling. The liquid in one of these pools can sometimes drop 100 or 150 feet while another pool at a higher elevation is overflowing, suggesting that there’s no connection between them. Similarly, lava overflows at the summit crater of Mount Loa, nearly 14,000 feet high, while the large lateral caldera of Kilauea remains calm as usual, providing no relief to the gases or molten material pushing their way upward in the center of the mountain. "How," Mr. Dana asks, "if there were any underground channel linking the two major vents, could this lack of connection exist? How can, according to the laws of hydrostatic pressure, a column of fluid stand 10,000 feet higher in one part of the siphon than in the other?" He points out that the eruptions are not sudden; rather, the lava rises slowly and gradually to the top of the high cone and then flows out without any noticeable activity in Kilauea, a vent that is always open on the sides of the same mountain. One conclusion he reaches is clear: volcanoes are not safety valves as they’ve been called; because here, two independent and seemingly isolated centers of volcanic activity, located just sixteen miles apart, exist within the same cone.553774

Without pretending to solve this enigma, I cannot refrain from remarking, that the supposed independence of several orifices of eruption in one crater like Kilauea, when adduced in confirmation of the doctrine of two distinct sources of volcanic action underneath one mountain, proves too much. No one can doubt, that the pools of lava in Kilauea have been derived from some common reservoir, and have resulted from a combination of causes commonly called volcanic, which are at work in the interior at some unknown distance below. These causes have given rise in Mount Loa to eruptions from many points, but principally from one centre, so that a vast dome of ejected matter has been piled up. The subsidiary crater has evidently never given much relief to the imprisoned, heated, and liquefied matter, for Kilauea does not form a lateral protuberance interfering with the general shape or uniform outline of Mount Loa.

Without trying to solve this mystery, I can't help but point out that the idea of several eruption vents being independent within a single crater like Kilauea, used to support the theory of two different sources of volcanic activity beneath one mountain, is too much to accept. It's clear that the lava pools in Kilauea come from a shared reservoir, resulting from a mix of what we generally call volcanic causes, which are operating at some unknown depth below. These causes have led to eruptions at various points on Mount Loa, but mainly from one central point, resulting in a large dome of expelled material. The smaller crater clearly hasn't provided much relief for the trapped, heated, and melted material, since Kilauea doesn't create a side protrusion that disrupts the overall shape or smooth outline of Mount Loa.

Geysers of Iceland.—As aqueous vapor constitutes the most abundant of the aeriform products of volcanoes in eruption, it may be well to consider attentively a case in which steam is exclusively the moving power—that of the Geysers of Iceland. These intermittent hot springs occur in a district situated in the southwestern division of Iceland, where nearly one hundred of them are said to break out within a circle of two miles. That the water is of atmospheric origin, derived from rain and melted snow, is proved, says Professor Bunsen, by the nitrogen which rises from them either pure or mixed with other gases. The springs rise through a thick current of lava, which may perhaps have flowed from Mount Hecla, the summit of that volcano being seen from the spot at the distance of more than thirty miles. In this district the rushing of water is sometimes heard in chasms beneath the surface; for here, as on Etna, rivers flow in subterranean channels through the porous and cavernous lavas. It has more than once happened, after earthquakes, that some of the boiling fountains have increased or diminished in violence and volume, or entirely ceased, or that new ones have made their appearance—changes which may be explained by the opening of new rents and the closing of pre-existing fissures.

Geysers of Iceland.—Since water vapor is the most common gas produced by erupting volcanoes, it’s worth looking closely at a situation where steam is the sole driving force—the Geysers of Iceland. These intermittent hot springs are found in a region in the southwestern part of Iceland, where nearly one hundred of them are said to erupt within a two-mile radius. The water comes from the atmosphere, sourced from rain and melted snow, as demonstrated by the nitrogen that rises from them, either by itself or mixed with other gases, according to Professor Bunsen. The springs flow through a thick layer of lava, which may have come from Mount Hecla, visible from the area over thirty miles away. In this region, the sound of rushing water can sometimes be heard in cracks beneath the surface; similar to Etna, rivers flow through underground channels in the porous and cavernous lava. After earthquakes, it has happened multiple times that some of the boiling fountains have changed in intensity and size, completely stopped, or new ones have appeared—alterations that can be explained by the formation of new cracks and the closure of existing ones.

Few of the Geysers play longer than five or six minutes at a time, although sometimes half an hour. The intervals between their eruptions are for the most part very irregular. The Great Geyser rises out of a spacious basin at the summit of a circular mound composed of siliceous incrustations deposited from the spray of its waters. The diameter of this basin, in one direction, is fifty-six feet, and forty-six in another. (See fig. 94.) In the centre is a pipe seventy-eight feet in perpendicular depth, and from eight to ten feet in diameter, but gradually widening, as it rises into the basin. The inside of the basin is whitish, consisting of a siliceous crust, and perfectly smooth, as are likewise two small 554 channels on the sides of the mound, down which the water escapes when the bowl is filled to the margin. The circular basin is sometimes empty, as represented in the following sketch; but is usually filled with beautifully transparent water in a state of ebullition. During the rise of the boiling water in the pipe, especially when the ebullition is most violent, and when the water is thrown up in jets, subterranean noises are heard, like the distant firing of cannon, and the earth is slightly shaken. The sound then increases and the motion becomes more violent, till at length a column of water is thrown up, with loud explosions, to the height of one or two hundred feet. After playing for a time like an artificial fountain, and giving off great clouds of vapor, the pipe or tube is emptied; and a column of steam, rushing up with amazing force and a thundering noise, terminates the eruption.

Few of the geysers go off for more than five or six minutes at a time, though sometimes they can last up to half an hour. The time between their eruptions is mostly pretty irregular. The Great Geyser shoots up from a large basin at the top of a circular mound made of siliceous deposits from its water spray. The diameter of this basin measures fifty-six feet in one direction and forty-six feet in another. (See fig. 94.) In the center, there’s a pipe that’s seventy-eight feet deep and eight to ten feet wide, but it gradually widens as it rises into the basin. The inside of the basin is whitish, covered with a smooth siliceous crust, and so are two small channels on the sides of the mound, which let the water escape when the bowl is filled to the brim. The circular basin can sometimes be empty, as shown in the following sketch, but it's usually filled with beautifully clear, boiling water. As the boiling water rises in the pipe, especially during the most intense bubbling when jets of water are thrown up, you can hear underground noises that sound like distant cannon fire, and the ground shakes slightly. The sound then grows louder and the motion becomes more forceful, until eventually, a column of water erupts up to a height of one or two hundred feet with loud explosions. After playing like a man-made fountain and releasing big clouds of vapor, the pipe gets emptied, and a column of steam rushes up with incredible force and a booming noise, ending the eruption.

Fig. 94.View of the Crater of the Great Geyser in Iceland.

View of the Crater of the Great Geyser in Iceland.775

View of the Crater of the Great Geyser in Iceland.775

If stones are thrown into the crater, they are instantly ejected; and such is the explosive force, that very hard rocks are sometimes shivered by it into small pieces. Henderson found that by throwing a great quantity of large stones into the pipe of Strockr, one of the Geysers, he could bring on an eruption in a few minutes.776 The fragments of stone, as well as the boiling water, were thrown in that case to a much greater height than usual. After the water had been ejected, a column of steam continued to rush up with a deafening roar for nearly an hour; but the Geyser, as if exhausted by this effort, did not send out a fresh eruption when its usual interval of rest had elapsed. The account given by Sir George Mackenzie of a Geyser which he saw in eruption in 1810 (see fig. 95), agrees perfectly with the above description by Henderson. The 555 steam and water rose for half an hour to the height of 70 feet, and the white column remained perpendicular notwithstanding a brisk gale of wind which was blowing against it. Stones thrown into the pipe were projected to a greater height than the water. To leeward of the vapor a heavy shower of rain was seen to fall.777

If you throw stones into the crater, they are instantly blasted out; the explosive force can even shatter very hard rocks into small pieces. Henderson discovered that by tossing a lot of large stones into the pipe of Strockr, one of the Geysers, he could trigger an eruption in just a few minutes.776 The fragments of stone, along with boiling water, shot much higher than usual in this case. After the water was expelled, a column of steam continued to surge upward with a deafening roar for nearly an hour; however, the Geyser, as if drained from this effort, did not produce another eruption when its usual resting period was over. Sir George Mackenzie’s account of a Geyser he witnessed erupting in 1810 (see fig. 95) perfectly matches Henderson’s description. The 555 steam and water towered for half an hour to a height of 70 feet, and the white column stood straight up despite a strong wind blowing against it. Stones thrown into the pipe were shot higher than the water. Downwind from the vapor, a heavy rain shower was observed.777

Fig. 95.Eruption of the New Geyser in 1810. (Mackenzie.)

Eruption of the New Geyser in 1810. (Mackenzie.)

Eruption of the New Geyser in 1810. (Mackenzie.)

Among the different theories proposed to account for these phenomena, I shall first mention one suggested by Sir. J. Herschel. An imitation of these jets, he says, may be produced on a small scale, by heating red hot the stem of a tobacco pipe, filling the bowl with water, and so inclining the pipe as to let the water run through the stem. Its escape, instead of taking place in a continued stream, is then performed by a succession of violent explosions, at first of steam alone, then of water mixed with steam; and, as the pipe cools, almost wholly of water. At every such paroxysmal escape of the water, a portion is driven back, accompanied with steam, into the bowl. The intervals between the explosions depend on the heat, length, and inclination of the pipe; their continuance, on its thickness and conducting power.778 The application of 556 this experiment to the Geysers merely requires that a subterranean stream, flowing through the pores and crevices of lava, should suddenly reach a fissure in which the rock is red hot or nearly so. Steam would immediately be formed, which, rushing up the fissure, might force up water along with it to the surface, while, at the same time, part of the steam might drive back the water of the supply for a certain distance towards its source. And when, after the space of some minutes, the steam was all condensed, the water would return, and a repetition of the phenomena take place.

Among the different theories suggested to explain these phenomena, I will first mention one proposed by Sir J. Herschel. He states that a small-scale imitation of these jets can be created by heating the stem of a tobacco pipe until it's red hot, filling the bowl with water, and tilting the pipe to let the water flow through the stem. Instead of flowing out continuously, the water escapes through a series of violent explosions, initially as steam alone, then as a mix of water and steam; and as the pipe cools, it’s mostly just water. With each explosive release of water, some is pushed back into the bowl with steam. The time between the explosions depends on the heat, length, and angle of the pipe; their duration depends on its thickness and ability to conduct heat.778 The application of this experiment to the Geysers simply requires that a subterranean stream, flowing through the pores and cracks of lava, suddenly encounters a fissure where the rock is red hot or close to it. Steam would form immediately, rushing up the fissure and forcing water to the surface, while some of the steam might push the supply water back a certain distance toward its source. After a few minutes, once all the steam has condensed, the water would return, and the phenomena would repeat.

Fig. 96.Supposed reservoir and pipe of a Geyser in Iceland.

Supposed reservoir and pipe of a Geyser in Iceland.779

Supposed reservoir and pipe of a Geyser in Iceland.779

There is, however, another mode of explaining the action of the Geyser, perhaps more probable than that above described. Suppose water percolating from the surface of the earth to penetrate into the subterranean cavity A D (fig. 96) by the fissures F F, while, at the same time, steam at an extremely high temperature, such as is commonly given out from the rents of lava currents during congelation, emanates from the fissures C. A portion of the steam is at first condensed into water, while the temperature of the water is raised by the latent heat thus evolved, till, at last, the lower part of the cavity is filled with boiling water and the upper with steam under high pressure. The expansive force of the steam becomes, at length, so great, that the water is forced up the fissure or pipe E B, and runs over the rim of the basin. When the pressure is thus diminished, the steam in the upper part of the cavity A expands, until all the water D is driven into the pipe; and when this 557 happens, the steam, being the lighter of the two fluids, rushes up through the water with great velocity. If the pipe be choked up artificially, even for a few minutes, a great increase of heat must take place; for it is prevented from escaping in a latent form in steam; so that the water is made to boil more violently, and this brings on an eruption.

There is, however, another way to explain how the Geyser works, which might be more likely than the one mentioned earlier. Imagine water filtering from the surface of the earth into the underground cavity A D (fig. 96) through the cracks F F, while at the same time, extremely hot steam, which often comes from the cracks of lava flows during solidification, is released from the openings C. Initially, some of the steam condenses into water, while the temperature of the water rises due to the latent heat produced until the lower part of the cavity is filled with boiling water and the upper part is filled with high-pressure steam. Eventually, the steam's expansive force becomes so strong that it pushes the water up through the fissure or pipe E B, causing it to overflow the basin. When the pressure decreases, the steam in the upper part of cavity A expands, pushing all the water D into the pipe; and when this happens, the lighter steam rushes up through the water at a high speed. If the pipe is blocked intentionally, even for a few minutes, a significant increase in heat occurs because it can't escape as latent steam, causing the water to boil more vigorously, leading to an eruption.

Professor Bunsen, before cited, adopts this theory to account for the play of the "Little Geyser," but says it will not explain the phenomena of the Great one. He considers this, like the others, to be a thermal spring, having a narrow funnel-shaped tube in the upper part of its course, where the walls of the channel have become coated over with siliceous incrustations. At the mouth of this tube the water has a temperature, corresponding to the pressure of the atmosphere, of about 212° Fahr., but at a certain depth below it is much hotter. This the professor succeeded in proving by experiment; a thermometer suspended by a string in the pipe rising to 266° Fahr., or no less than 48 degrees above the boiling point. After the column of water has been expelled, what remains in the basin and pipe is found to be much cooled.

Professor Bunsen, previously mentioned, uses this theory to explain the behavior of the "Little Geyser," but he states it doesn't clarify the phenomena of the Great Geyser. He believes this, like the others, is a thermal spring with a narrow funnel-shaped tube at the top. The walls of the channel are covered in siliceous deposits. At the opening of this tube, the water temperature is around 212° Fahrenheit, which matches atmospheric pressure, but it gets much hotter at a certain depth below. The professor proved this through experiments; a thermometer hanging by a string in the pipe showed a temperature of 266° Fahrenheit, which is 48 degrees above the boiling point. After the water column is expelled, what's left in the basin and pipe is found to be much cooler.

Previously to these experiments of Bunsen and Descloizeaux, made in Iceland in 1846, it would scarcely have been supposed possible that the lower part of a free and open column of water could be raised so much in temperature without causing a circulation of ascending and descending currents, followed by an almost immediate equalization of heat. Such circulation is no doubt impeded greatly by the sides of the well not being vertical, and by numerous contractions of its diameter, but the phenomenon may be chiefly due to another cause. According to recent experiments on the cohesion of liquids by Mr. Donny of Ghent, it appears that when water is freed from all admixture of air, its temperature can be raised, even under ordinary atmospheric pressure, to 275° Fahr., so much does the cohesion of its molecules increase780 when they are not separated by particles of air. As water long boiled becomes more and more deprived of air, it is probably very free from such intermixture at the bottom of the Geysers.

Before the experiments by Bunsen and Descloizeaux in Iceland in 1846, it would have been hard to believe that the lower part of a free and open column of water could have its temperature raised so much without causing a circulation of rising and falling currents, which would normally lead to an almost immediate equalization of heat. Such circulation is likely hindered greatly by the well's walls not being vertical and by various contractions in its diameter, but the phenomenon may primarily be due to another factor. According to recent experiments on liquid cohesion by Mr. Donny of Ghent, it seems that when water is completely free of air, its temperature can be raised to 275° Fahrenheit, even under regular atmospheric pressure, because the cohesion of its molecules increases significantly when they are not disturbed by air particles. As water boils over time and loses more and more air, it is probably very low in air content at the bottom of the Geysers.

Among other results of the experiments of Bunsen and his companion, they convinced themselves that the column of fluid filling the tube is constantly receiving accessions of hot water from below, while it becomes cooler above by evaporation on the broad surface of the basin. They also came to a conclusion of no small interest, as bearing on the probable mechanism of ordinary volcanic eruptions, namely that the tube itself is the main seat or focus of mechanical force. This was proved by letting down stones suspended by strings to various depths. Those which were sunk to considerable distances from the surface were not cast up again, whereas those nearer the mouth of the tube were ejected to great heights. Other experiments also were made tending to demonstrate the singular fact, that there is often scarce any motion below, when a violent rush of steam and water is taking place above. It seems 558 that when a lofty column of water possesses a temperature increasing with the depth, any slight ebullition or disturbance of equilibrium in the upper portion may first force up water into the basin, and then cause it to flow over the edge. A lower portion, thus suddenly relieved of part of its pressure, expands and is converted into vapor more rapidly than the first, owing to its greater heat. This allows the next subjacent stratum, which is much hotter, to rise and flash into a gaseous form; and this process goes on till the ebullition has descended from the middle to near the bottom of the funnel.781

Among other results from Bunsen and his companion's experiments, they found that the column of fluid in the tube is constantly getting hot water from below, while it cools off above due to evaporation on the broad surface of the basin. They reached an interesting conclusion regarding the probable mechanism of regular volcanic eruptions: that the tube itself is the main center of mechanical force. This was demonstrated by lowering stones held by strings to various depths. Those that were lowered significantly from the surface were not pushed back up, while those closer to the mouth of the tube were ejected to great heights. They conducted additional experiments showing the unusual fact that there’s often little movement below when a sudden rush of steam and water occurs above. It appears that when a tall column of water gets hotter with depth, even a slight bubbling or disturbance in the upper part may initially push water into the basin and then cause it to overflow. The lower part, quickly relieved of some of its pressure, expands and turns into vapor faster than the upper part due to its higher temperature. This allows the next layer below, which is much hotter, to rise and turn into gas; this process continues until the bubbling has moved down from the middle to near the bottom of the funnel.781

In speculating, therefore, on the mechanism of an ordinary volcanic eruption, we may suppose that large subterranean cavities exist at the depth of some miles below the surface of the earth, in which melted lava accumulates; and when water containing the usual mixture of air penetrates into these, the steam thus generated may press upon the lava and force it up the duct of a volcano, in the same manner as a column of water is driven up the pipe of a Geyser. In other cases we may suppose a continuous column of liquid lava mixed with red-hot water (for water may exist in that state, as Professor Bunsen reminds us, under pressure), and this column may have a temperature regularly increasing downwards. A disturbance of equilibrium may first bring on an eruption near the surface, by the expansion and conversion into gas of entangled water and other constituents of what we call lava, so as to occasion a diminution of pressure. More steam would then be liberated, carrying up with it jets of melted rock, which being hurled up into the air may fall in showers of ashes on the surrounding country, and at length, by the arrival of lava and water more and more heated at the orifice of the duct or the crater of the volcano, expansive power may be acquired sufficient to expel a massive current of lava. After the eruption has ceased, a period of tranquillity succeeds, during which fresh accessions of heat are communicated from below, and additional masses of rock fused by degrees, while at the same time atmospheric or sea water is descending from the surface. At length the conditions required for a new outburst are obtained, and another cycle of similar changes is renewed.

In speculating about how a typical volcanic eruption works, we can imagine that there are large underground cavities several miles deep where melted lava collects. When water that contains the usual mix of air seeps into these cavities, the steam produced can push the lava up through the volcano's pipe, similar to how water is forced up the pipe of a Geyser. In other instances, we might think of a continuous column of liquid lava mixed with red-hot water (since, as Professor Bunsen points out, water can exist in that form under pressure), with the temperature gradually increasing as we go deeper. A disturbance in the balance could trigger an eruption near the surface by causing water and other components in the lava to expand and turn into gas, which would reduce the pressure. More steam would then be released, carrying jets of melted rock skyward, which would fall as ash on the surrounding area. Eventually, as more heated lava and water reach the volcano's opening or crater, the pressure would build enough to push out a significant flow of lava. After the eruption ends, a peaceful period follows, during which more heat is transferred from below, and additional rock is slowly melted, while atmospheric or seawater continues to seep down from above. Eventually, the right conditions for another eruption are met, and a new cycle of similar changes begins.

Causes of earthquakes—wave-like motion.—I shall now proceed to examine the manner in which the heat of the interior may give rise to earthquakes. One of the most common phenomena attending subterranean movements, is the undulatory motion of the ground. And this, says Michell, will seem less extraordinary, if we call to mind the extreme elasticity of the earth and the compressibility of even the most solid materials. Large districts, he suggests, may rest on fluid lava; and, when this is disturbed, its motions may be propagated through the incumbent rocks. He also adds the following ingenious speculation:—"As a small quantity of vapor almost instantly generated at some considerable 559 depth below the surface of the earth will produce a vibratory motion, so a very large quantity (whether it be generated almost instantly, or in any small portion of time) will produce a wave-like motion. The manner in which this wave-like motion will be propagated may, in some measure, be represented by the following experiment:—Suppose a large cloth, or carpet (spread upon a floor), to be raised at one edge, and then suddenly brought down again to the floor; the air under it, being by this means propelled, will pass along till it escapes at the opposite side, raising the cloth in a wave all the way as it goes. In like manner, a large quantity of vapor may be conceived to raise the earth in a wave, as it passes along between the strata, which it may easily separate in a horizontal direction, there being little or no cohesion between one stratum and another. The part of the earth that is first raised being bent from its natural form, will endeavor to restore itself by its elasticity; and the parts next to it being to have their weight supported by the vapor, which will insinuate itself under them, will be raised in their turn, till it either finds some vent, or is again condensed by the cold into water, and by that means prevented from proceeding any farther."782 In a memoir published in 1843, on the structure of the Appalachian chain, by the Professors Rogers,783 the following hypothesis is proposed as "simpler and more in accordance with dynamical considerations, and the recorded observations on earthquakes."—"In place," say they, "of supposing it possible for a body of vapor or gaseous matter to pass horizontally between the strata, or even between the crust and the fluid lava upon which it floats, and with which it must be closely entangled, we are inclined to attribute the movement to an actual pulsation, engendered in the molten matter itself, by a linear disruption under enormous tension, giving vent explosively to elastic vapors, escaping either to the surface, or into cavernous spaces beneath. According to this supposition, the movement of the subterranean vapors would be towards, and not from, the disrupted belt, and the oscillation of the crust would originate in the tremendous and sudden disturbance of the previous pressure on the surface of the lava mass below, brought about by the instantaneous and violent rending of the overlying strata."

Causes of earthquakes—wave-like motion.—I will now look into how the heat from inside the Earth can cause earthquakes. One of the most common things that happen with underground movements is the wave-like motion of the ground. Michell suggests that this won't seem so surprising when we consider how extremely elastic the Earth is and how even the most solid materials can be compressed. He proposes that large areas might be sitting on fluid lava; when this lava is disturbed, its movement could spread through the rocks above it. He also offers this interesting idea: “Just as a small amount of vapor generated quickly at a significant depth below the Earth's surface can create a vibrating motion, a much larger amount (whether it's generated instantly or over a short period) will cause a wave-like motion. We can visualize how this wave-like motion might spread using the following experiment: Imagine a large cloth or carpet laid on the floor, lifted at one edge and then suddenly dropped back onto the floor; the air underneath gets pushed and moves until it escapes at the other side, creating a wave along the cloth as it travels. Similarly, a large amount of vapor could be thought of as lifting the Earth in a wave as it moves through the layers, easily separating them horizontally since there is little to no cohesion between the layers. The part of the Earth that rises first gets bent out of its natural shape and tries to return to its original form because of its elasticity. The adjacent parts then have their weight supported by the vapor that pushes up from beneath, raising them too, until the vapor either finds an escape route or condenses back into water due to the cold, preventing further movement."559 In a paper published in 1843 about the structure of the Appalachian chain by Professors Rogers,783 they propose the following hypothesis as "simpler and more aligned with dynamical considerations and recorded observations on earthquakes."—“Instead of assuming that a body of vapor or gas can move horizontally between the layers or even between the crust and the fluid lava it floats on, with which it must be tightly mixed, we believe the movement is due to an actual pulsation generated in the molten matter itself by a linear disruption under extreme tension, explosively releasing elastic vapors that escape either to the surface or into cavernous spaces below. According to this idea, the movement of the underground vapors would be towards the disrupted area, not away from it, and the oscillation of the crust would come from the intense and sudden change in pressure on the surface of the molten mass below, caused by the rapid and violent tearing of the layers above."

This theory requires us to admit that the crust of the earth is so flexible, that it can assume the form, and follow the motion of an undulation in the fluid below. Even if we grant this, says Mr. Mallet, another more serious objection presents itself, viz. the great velocity attributed to the transit of the wave in the subterranean sea of lava. We are called upon to admit that the speed of the wave below equals that of the true earthquake shock at the surface, which is so immense, that it is not inferior to the velocity of sound in the same solids. But the undulation in the fluid below must follow the laws of a tidal wave, or of the great sea-wave already spoken of. "Its velocity, like that of the tidal wave 560 of our seas, will be a function of its length and of the depth of the fluid, diminished in this case by certain considerations as to the density and degree of viscidity of the liquid; and although it would be at present impossible, for want of data, to calculate the exact velocity with which this subterraneous lava-wave could move, it may be certainly affirmed that its velocity would be immeasurably short of the observed or theoretic velocity of the great earth-wave, or true shock in earthquakes."784

This theory requires us to accept that the Earth's crust is so flexible that it can take on the shape and follow the movement of a wave in the fluid beneath it. Even if we agree with this, Mr. Mallet points out another, more serious objection: the extremely high speed that is said to be associated with the movement of the wave in the underground sea of lava. We have to accept that the speed of the wave below is equal to that of the actual earthquake shock at the surface, which is so great that it matches the speed of sound in similar solids. However, the wave in the fluid below must follow the principles of a tidal wave or the large sea-waves mentioned earlier. "Its speed, like that of the tidal wave of our seas, will depend on its length and the depth of the fluid, reduced in this case by certain factors related to the density and thickness of the liquid; and although it is currently impossible, due to lack of data, to calculate the exact speed at which this underground lava wave might travel, it can certainly be said that its speed would be far less than the observed or theoretical speed of the massive earth-wave, or the actual shock during earthquakes."560

Liquid gases.—The rending and upheaving of continental masses are operations which are not difficult to explain, when we are once convinced that heat, of sufficient power, not only to melt but to reduce to a gaseous form a great variety of substances, is accumulated in certain parts of the interior. We see that elastic fluids are capable of projecting solid masses to immense heights in the air; and the volcano of Cotopaxi has been known to throw out, to the distance of eight or nine miles, a mass of rock about one hundred cubic yards in volume. When we observe these aeriform fluids rushing out from particular vents for months, or even years, continuously, what power may we not expect them to exert in other places, where they happen to be confined under an enormous weight of rock?

Liquid gases.—The tearing and shifting of continental land masses are processes that become easier to understand once we accept that heat, strong enough not just to melt but to turn a variety of substances into gas, is collected in certain areas within the Earth. We see that gases can launch solid objects to great heights in the air; for example, the Cotopaxi volcano has been known to eject a chunk of rock about one hundred cubic yards in size to a distance of eight or nine miles. When we notice these gases escaping from specific vents for months or even years on end, just imagine the power they could unleash in other places where they are trapped under heavy layers of rock.

The experiments of Faraday and others have shown, within the last twelve years, that many of the gases, including all those which are most copiously disengaged from volcanic vents, as the carbonic, sulphurous, and muriatic acids, may be condensed into liquids by pressure. At temperatures of from 30° to 50° F., the pressure required for this purpose varies from fifteen to fifty atmospheres; and this amount of pressure we may regard as very insignificant in the operations of nature. A column of Vesuvian lava that would reach from the lip of the crater to the level of the sea, must be equal to about three hundred atmospheres; so that, at depths which may be termed moderate in the interior of the crust of the earth, the gases may be condensed into liquids, even at very high temperatures. The method employed to reduce some of these gases to a liquid state is, to confine the materials, from the mutual action of which they are evolved, in tubes hermetically sealed, so that the accumulated pressure of the vapor, as it rises and expands, may force some part of it to assume the liquid state. A similar process may, and indeed must, frequently take place in subterranean caverns and fissures, or even in the pores and cells of many rocks; by which means, a much greater store of expansive power may be packed into a small space than could happen if these vapors had not the property of becoming liquid. For, although the gas occupies much less room in a liquid state, yet it exerts exactly the same pressure upon the sides of the containing cavity as if it remained in the form of vapor.

The experiments by Faraday and others have shown, in the past twelve years, that many gases, including those that are most commonly released from volcanic vents—like carbon dioxide, sulfur dioxide, and hydrochloric acid—can be turned into liquids through pressure. At temperatures between 30° and 50° F, the pressure needed for this ranges from fifteen to fifty atmospheres; this level of pressure is quite low in the natural world. A column of Vesuvian lava stretching from the crater's edge to sea level would be about three hundred atmospheres; thus, at what could be considered moderate depths within the Earth's crust, gases can be liquefied even at very high temperatures. The method used to liquefy some of these gases involves trapping the materials from which they come in airtight tubes, allowing the growing pressure from the vapor as it rises and expands to force some of it to turn into a liquid. A similar process can, and often does, occur in underground caverns and cracks, or even within the tiny spaces and cells of various rocks; this allows for a much larger amount of force to be concentrated in a small area than would be possible if these vapors couldn’t turn into liquid. This is because, while gases take up less space in liquid form, they exert the same pressure against the walls of their container as they would if they remained as vapor.

If a tube, whether of glass or other materials, filled with condensed gas, have its temperature slightly raised, it will often burst; for a slight increment of heat causes the elasticity of the gas to increase in a very 561 high ratio. We have only to suppose certain rocks, permeated by these liquid gases (as porous strata are sometimes filled with water), to have their temperature raised some hundred degrees, and we obtain a power capable of lifting superincumbent masses of almost any conceivable thickness; while, if the depth at which the gas is confined be great, there is no reason to suppose that any other appearances would be witnessed by the inhabitants of the surface than vibratory movements and rents, from which no vapor might escape. In making their way through fissures a very few miles only in length, or in forcing a passage through soft yielding strata, the vapors may be cooled and absorbed by water. For water has a strong affinity to several of the gases, and will absorb large quantities, with a very slight increase of volume. In this manner, the heat or the volume of springs may be augmented, and their mineral properties made to vary.

If a tube made of glass or other materials is filled with compressed gas and its temperature is slightly raised, it can often burst; a small increase in heat leads to a significant rise in the gas's pressure. We can imagine certain rocks that are saturated with these liquid gases (similar to how porous rock layers can be filled with water) having their temperature increased by several hundred degrees, giving us enough power to lift massive weights of nearly any thickness. If the gas is trapped at a great depth, there’s no reason to believe that the people on the surface would notice anything other than vibrations and cracks, from which no vapor could escape. As the gases move through cracks only a few miles long or push their way through softer layers, they may cool down and get absorbed by water. Water has a strong attraction to many gases and can absorb large amounts with only a slight increase in volume. This way, the heat or the volume of springs can be increased, and their mineral content can change.

Connection between the state of the atmosphere and earthquakes.—The inhabitants of Stromboli, who are mostly fishermen, are said to make use of that volcano as a weather-glass, the eruptions being comparatively feeble when the sky is serene, but increasing in turbulence during tempestuous weather, so that in winter the island often seems to shake from its foundations. Mr. P. Scrope, after calling attention to these and other analogous facts, first started the idea (as long ago as the year 1825) that the diminished pressure of the atmosphere, the concomitant of stormy weather, may modify the intensity of the volcanic action. He suggests that where liquid lava communicates with the surface, as in the crater of Stromboli, it may rise or fall in the vent on the same principle as mercury in a barometer; because the ebullition or expansive power of the steam contained in the lava would be checked by every increase, and augmented by every diminution of weight. In like manner, if a bed of liquid lava be confined at an immense depth below the surface, its expansive force may be counteracted partly by the weight of the incumbent rocks, and also in part by atmospheric pressure acting contemporaneously on a vast superficial area. In that case, if the upheaving force increase gradually in energy, it will at length be restrained by only the slightest degree of superiority in the antagonist or repressive power, and then the equilibrium may be suddenly destroyed by any cause, such as an ascending draught of air, which is capable of depressing the barometer. In this manner we may account for the remarkable coincidence so frequently observed between the state of the weather and subterranean commotions, although it must be admitted that earthquakes and volcanic eruptions react in their turn upon the atmosphere, so that disturbances of the latter are generally the consequences rather than the forerunners of volcanic disturbances.785

Connection between the state of the atmosphere and earthquakes.—The people living on Stromboli, mostly fishermen, are known to use the volcano as a weather indicator. The eruptions are relatively mild when the skies are clear but become more intense during storms, causing the island to feel like it's shaking from its very core in winter. Mr. P. Scrope highlighted these and other similar observations and first proposed the idea back in 1825 that lower atmospheric pressure, which coincides with bad weather, might change the intensity of volcanic activity. He suggests that where liquid lava meets the surface, like in the crater of Stromboli, it may rise or fall in the vent based on the same principle as mercury in a barometer; the boiling or expanding steam in the lava would be limited by any increase in weight and boosted by any decrease. Similarly, if a pool of liquid lava is trapped deep underground, its expanding force could be countered partly by the weight of the rocks above and also by atmospheric pressure acting simultaneously on a large surface area. If the force pushing up gradually grows stronger, it can eventually be held back by just a small increase in the opposing pressure, and then the balance can be suddenly upset by something like a rising draft of air that can lower the barometer. This explains the often noted connection between weather conditions and underground movements, although it's important to recognize that earthquakes and volcanic eruptions can also affect the atmosphere, making disturbances more often a result rather than a trigger of volcanic activity.785

From an elaborate catalogue of the earthquakes experienced in Europe and Syria during the last fifteen centuries, M. Alexis Perrey has deduced the conclusion that the number which happen in the winter 562 season preponderates over those which occur in any one of the other seasons of the year, there being, however, some exceptions to this rule, as in the Pyrenees. Curious and valuable as are these data, M. d'Archiac justly remarks, in commenting upon them, that they are not as yet sufficiently extensive or accordant in different regions, to entitle us to deduce any general conclusions from them respecting the laws of subterranean movements throughout the globe.786

From a detailed catalog of the earthquakes that have occurred in Europe and Syria over the last fifteen centuries, M. Alexis Perrey has concluded that more earthquakes happen in the winter season than in any other season of the year, although there are some exceptions to this rule, such as in the Pyrenees. While this data is interesting and valuable, M. d'Archiac rightly points out in his commentary that it is still not extensive or consistent enough across different regions to allow us to make any general conclusions about the patterns of underground movements worldwide.786

Permanent elevation and subsidence.—It is easy to conceive that the shattered rocks may assume an arched form during a convulsion, so that the country above may remain permanently upheaved. In other cases gas may drive before it masses of liquid lava, which may thus be injected into newly opened fissures. The gas having then obtained more room, by the forcing up of the incumbent rocks, may remain at rest; while the lava congealing in the rents may afford a solid foundation for the newly raised district.

Permanent elevation and subsidence.—It's easy to imagine that broken rocks can take on an arched shape during an upheaval, causing the land above to stay permanently raised. In other situations, gas can push large amounts of liquid lava, which may then fill newly opened cracks. Once the gas has more space due to the uplift of the overlying rocks, it may settle down; meanwhile, the lava solidifying in the cracks can provide a stable foundation for the newly elevated area.

Experiments have recently been made in America, by Colonel Totten, to ascertain the ratio according to which some of the stones commonly used in architecture expand with given increments of heat.787 It was found impossible, in a country where the annual variation of temperature was more than 90° F., to make a coping of stones, five feet in length, in which the joints should fit so tightly as not to admit water between the stone and the cement; the annual contraction and expansion of the stones causing, at the junctions, small crevices, the width of which varied with the nature of the rock. It was ascertained that fine-grained granite expanded with 1° F. at the rate of ·000004825; while crystalline marble ·000005668; and red sandstone ·000009532, or about twice as much as granite.

Experiments have recently been conducted in America by Colonel Totten to determine how some of the stones typically used in architecture expand with specific temperature increases.787 It was found to be impossible, in a country where the yearly temperature variation exceeds 90° F., to create a stone coping measuring five feet in length with joints that fit so tightly that no water could seep between the stone and the cement; the annual contraction and expansion of the stones caused small gaps at the joints, with the width varying depending on the type of rock. It was determined that fine-grained granite expanded at a rate of 0.000004825 per degree Fahrenheit, crystalline marble at 0.000005668, and red sandstone at 0.000009532, which is about twice as much as granite.

Now, according to this law of expansion, a mass of sandstone a mile in thickness, which should have its temperature raised 200° F., would lift a superimposed layer of rock to the height of ten feet above its former level. But, suppose a part of the earth's crust, one hundred miles in thickness and equally expansive, to have its temperature raised 600° or 800°, this might produce an elevation of between two and three thousand feet. The cooling of the same mass might afterwards cause the overlying rocks to sink down again and resume their original position. By such agency we might explain the gradual rise of Scandinavia or the subsidence of Greenland, if this last phenomenon should also be established as a fact on farther inquiry.

Now, based on this principle of expansion, a layer of sandstone that's a mile thick, when its temperature is increased by 200°F, would lift a layer of rock on top by ten feet above its previous level. But, if a section of the earth's crust, one hundred miles thick and just as expansive, were to have its temperature raised by 600° or 800°, it could result in an elevation of two to three thousand feet. If that same mass cools down later, it might cause the rocks above to sink back down to their original position. This process could help explain the gradual rise of Scandinavia or the sinking of Greenland, if further investigation confirms this phenomenon.

It is also possible that as the clay in Wedgwood's pyrometer contracts, by giving off its water, and then, by incipient vitrification; so, large masses of argillaceous strata on the earth's interior may shrink, when subjected to heat and chemical changes, and allow the incumbent rocks to subside gradually.

It is also possible that as the clay in Wedgwood's pyrometer shrinks by losing its water, and then begins to vitrify; large amounts of clay-rich layers deep within the Earth may also shrink when exposed to heat and chemical changes, causing the rocks above them to gradually settle.

Moreover, if we suppose that lava cooling slowly at great depths 563 may be converted into various granitic rocks, we obtain another source of depression; for, according to the experiments of Deville and the calculations of Bischoff, the contraction of granite when passing from a melted or plastic to a solid and crystalline state must be more than ten per cent.788 The sudden subsidence of land may also be occasioned by subterranean caverns giving way, when gases are condensed, or when they escape through newly-formed crevices. The subtraction, moreover, of matter from certain parts of the interior, by the flowing of lava and of mineral springs, must, in the course of ages, cause vacuities below, so that the undermined surface may at length fall in.

Moreover, if we assume that lava cooling slowly at great depths 563 can turn into various types of granite, we have another reason for land to sink; based on the experiments of Deville and the calculations of Bischoff, granite shrinks by more than ten percent when it changes from a melted or plastic state to a solid and crystalline one.788 The sudden sinking of land can also happen when underground caverns collapse due to gas buildup or when gases escape through new cracks. Additionally, as lava and mineral springs flow, they remove material from certain areas underground, which over time can create empty spaces below, leading to the surface collapsing.

The balance of dry land, how preserved.—In the present state of our knowledge, we cannot pretend to estimate the average number of earthquakes which may happen in the course of a single year. As the area of the ocean is nearly three times that of the land, it is probable that about three submarine earthquakes may occur for one exclusively continental; and when we consider the great frequency of slight movements in certain districts, we can hardly suppose that a day, if, indeed, an hour, ever passes without one or more shocks being experienced in some part of the globe. We have also seen that in Sweden, and other countries, changes in the relative level of sea and land may take place without commotion, and these perhaps produce the most important geographical and geological changes; for the position of land may be altered to a greater amount by an elevation or depression of one inch over a vast area, than by the sinking of a more limited tract, such as the forest of Aripao, to the depth of many fathoms at once.789

The balance of dry land, how preserved.—Based on what we know today, we can't really estimate how many earthquakes might happen in a single year. Since the area of the ocean is nearly three times that of the land, it's likely that about three underwater earthquakes occur for every one that happens on land. When we think about how often small tremors happen in certain areas, it's hard to believe that a day—if not even an hour—goes by without at least one shock being felt somewhere in the world. We've also observed that in Sweden and other countries, changes in the relative levels of sea and land can occur without any noticeable upheaval, and these might actually lead to the most significant geographical and geological changes. A large area can see more substantial alterations due to an inch of uplift or subsidence than a smaller area like the Aripao forest sinking many fathoms at once.789

It must be evident, from the historical details above given, that the force of subterranean movement, whether intermittent or continuous, whether with or without disturbance, does not operate at random, but is developed in certain regions only; and although the alterations produced during the time required for the occurrence of a few volcanic eruptions may be inconsiderable, we can hardly doubt that, during the ages necessary for the formation of large volcanic cones, composed of thousands of lava currents, shoals might be converted into lofty mountains, and low lands into deep seas.

It should be clear from the historical details provided above that the force of underground movement, whether sporadic or continuous, with or without disruption, does not happen randomly but develops in specific areas only. And while the changes that take place during the timespan of a few volcanic eruptions may be minor, we can hardly question that over the ages required to form large volcanic cones, made up of thousands of lava flows, shallows could be turned into towering mountains, and lowlands into deep seas.

In a former chapter (p. 198), I have stated that aqueous and igneous agents may be regarded as antagonist forces; the aqueous laboring incessantly to reduce the inequalities of the earth's surface to a level, while the igneous are equally active in renewing the unevenness of the surface. By some geologists it has been thought that the levelling power of running water was opposed rather to the elevating force of earthquakes than to their action generally. This opinion is, however, untenable; for the sinking down of the bed of the ocean is one of the means by which the gradual submersion of land is prevented. The depth of the sea cannot be increased at any one point without a universal fall of the waters, nor can any partial deposition of sediment occur without 564 the displacement of a quantity of water of equal volume, which will raise the sea, though in an imperceptible degree, even to the antipodes. The preservation, therefore, of the dry land may sometimes be effected by the subsidence of part of the earth's crust (that part, namely, which is covered by the ocean), and in like manner an upheaving movement must often tend to destroy land; for if it render the bed of the sea more shallow, it will displace a certain quantity of water, and thus tend to submerge low tracts.

In a previous chapter (p. 198), I mentioned that water and volcanic forces can be seen as opposing forces; water continuously works to flatten the unevenness of the earth's surface, while volcanic activity is equally busy creating new unevenness. Some geologists have suggested that the leveling effect of flowing water is more in opposition to the uplifting force of earthquakes than to their overall action. However, this viewpoint is not valid; the sinking of the ocean floor is one way to prevent the gradual submersion of land. You can't increase the depth of the sea at any point without causing a universal drop in water levels, nor can any partial deposition of sediment happen without displacing an equal volume of water, which will slightly raise the sea level even at extreme distances. Thus, the preservation of dry land can sometimes occur due to the subsidence of part of the earth's crust (specifically, the part under the ocean), and similarly, an upward movement can often lead to land loss; if it makes the sea floor shallower, it will displace a certain amount of water, which can submerge low-lying areas.

Astronomers having proved (see above, p. 129) that there has been no change in the diameter of the earth during the last two thousand years, we may assume it as probable, that the dimensions of the planet remain uniform. If, then, we inquire in what manner the force of earthquakes must be regulated, in order to restore perpetually the inequalities of the surface which the levelling power of water tends to efface, it will be found, that the amount of depression must exceed that of elevation. It would be otherwise if the action of volcanoes and mineral springs were suspended; for then the forcing outwards of the earth's envelope ought to be no more than equal to its sinking in.

Astronomers have demonstrated (see above, p. 129) that there has been no change in the Earth's diameter over the past two thousand years, so we can reasonably assume that the planet's dimensions are stable. Therefore, if we explore how earthquake forces need to be adjusted to constantly restore the surface inequalities that water tends to smooth out, we will find that the amount of sinking must be greater than the amount of rising. This would be different if volcanic activity and mineral springs were inactive; in that case, the pressure from the Earth's outer layers would only need to match the amount of sinking.

To understand this proposition more clearly, it must be borne in mind, that the deposits of rivers and currents probably add as much to the height of lands which are rising, as they take from those which have risen. Suppose a large river to bring down sediment to a part of the ocean two thousand feet deep, and that the depth of this part is gradually reduced by the accumulation of sediment till only a shoal remains, covered by water at high tides; if now an upheaving force should uplift this shoal to the height of 2000 feet, the result would be a mountain 2000 feet high. But had the movement raised the same part of the bottom of the sea before the sediment of the river had filled it up; then, instead of changing a shoal into a mountain 2000 feet high, it would only have converted a deep sea into a shoal.

To understand this idea more clearly, it's important to remember that the sediment from rivers and currents likely adds just as much to the height of rising lands as it takes away from those that have already risen. Imagine a large river depositing sediment into a part of the ocean that's 2,000 feet deep, and over time the depth of this area decreases because of the sediment buildup until only a shallow area remains, submerged at high tides. If an uplifting force were then to raise this shallow area to a height of 2,000 feet, the result would be a mountain that is 2,000 feet high. However, if the movement had lifted the same section of the ocean floor before the river's sediment had filled it, instead of turning a shallow area into a mountain 2,000 feet high, it would have simply changed a deep part of the sea into a shallow area.

It appears, then, that the operations of the earthquake are often such as to cause the levelling power of water to counteract itself; and, although the idea may appear paradoxical, we may be sure, wherever we find hills and mountains composed of stratified deposits, that such inequalities of the surface would have had no existence if water, at some former period, had not been laboring to reduce the earth's surface to one level.

It seems that the effects of earthquakes often allow the leveling power of water to cancel itself out. And although this idea might seem contradictory, we can be certain that wherever we see hills and mountains made up of layered deposits, those surface irregularities wouldn't exist if water hadn't been working to flatten the earth's surface at some point in the past.

But, besides the transfer of matter by running water from the continents to the ocean, there is a constant transportation from below upwards, by mineral springs and volcanic vents. As mountain masses are, in the course of ages, created by the pouring forth of successive streams of lava, so stratified rocks, of great extent, originate from the deposition of carbonate of lime, and other mineral ingredients, with which springs are impregnated. The surface of the land, and portions of the bottom of the sea, being thus raised, the external accessions due to these operations would cause the dimensions of the planet to enlarge continually, if the amount of depression of the earth's crust were no more than equal 565 to the elevation. In order, therefore, that the mean diameter of the earth should remain uniform, and the unevenness of the surface be preserved, it is necessary that the amount of subsidence should be in excess. And such a predominance of depression is far from improbable, on mechanical principles, since every upheaving movement must be expected either to produce caverns in the mass below, or to cause some diminution of its density. Vacuities must, also, arise from the subtraction of the matter poured out from volcanoes and mineral springs, or from the contraction of argillaceous masses by subterranean heat; and the foundations having been thus weakened, the earth's crust, shaken and rent by reiterated convulsions, must, in the course of time, fall in.

But besides the movement of material by rivers from the continents to the ocean, there is also a constant upward movement from below, driven by mineral springs and volcanic vents. Over time, mountains are formed by the repeated eruption of lava streams, while thick layers of rock come from the deposition of limestone and other minerals carried by these springs. As the land and parts of the sea floor are elevated, the external additions from these processes would cause the size of the planet to keep expanding, if the sinking of the earth's crust was just enough to match the rising. Therefore, for the average diameter of the earth to stay consistent and the surface irregularities to be maintained, the amount of sinking must be greater. This dominance of sinking is quite plausible, based on mechanical principles, since any upward movement is expected to create voids in the ground below or reduce its density. Empty spaces can also develop from the removal of material expelled by volcanoes and mineral springs, or from the shrinking of clayey material due to underground heat; and as these foundations weaken, the earth's crust, shaken and fractured by repeated disturbances, must eventually collapse.

If we embrace these views, important geological consequences will follow; since, if there be, upon the whole, more subsidence than elevation, the average depth to which former surfaces have sunk beneath their original level must exceed the height which ancient marine strata have attained above the sea. If, for example, marine strata, about the age of our chalk and greensand, have been lifted up in Europe to an extreme height of more than eleven thousand feet, and a mean elevation of some hundreds, we may conclude that certain parts of the surface, which existed when those strata were deposited, have sunk to an extreme depth of more than eleven thousand feet below their original level, and to a mean depth of more than a few hundreds.

If we accept these ideas, significant geological results will follow; since, if there is, overall, more subsidence than elevation, the average depth to which past surfaces have dropped below their original level must be greater than the height that ancient marine layers have reached above sea level. For instance, if marine layers, dating back to the time of our chalk and greensand, have risen in Europe to a maximum height of over eleven thousand feet, and an average elevation of several hundred feet, we can conclude that some areas of the surface, which were in place when those layers were formed, have sunk to a maximum depth of more than eleven thousand feet below their original level, and to an average depth of more than a few hundred feet.

In regard to faults, also, we must infer, according to the hypothesis now proposed, that a greater number have arisen from the sinking down than from the elevation of rocks.

In terms of faults, we must conclude, based on the hypothesis currently suggested, that more have occurred due to the sinking of rocks than from their uplift.

To conclude: it seems to be rendered probable, by the views above explained, that the constant repair of the land, and the subserviency of our planet to the support of terrestrial as well as aquatic species, are secured by the elevating and depressing power of causes acting in the interior of the earth; which, although so often the source of death and terror to the inhabitants of the globe—visiting in succession every zone, and filling the earth with monuments of ruin and disorder—are nevertheless the agents of a conservative principle above all others essential to the stability of the system.

To sum up: it seems likely, based on the ideas discussed above, that the ongoing maintenance of the land and the Earth's role in supporting both land and water species are ensured by the rising and falling forces operating within the Earth. These forces, while frequently causing death and fear for the planet's inhabitants—affecting every region in turn and leaving behind reminders of destruction and chaos—are still the key players in a fundamental principle essential for the stability of the system.


BOOK III.

CHAPTER XXXIII.

CHANGES OF THE ORGANIC WORLD NOW IN PROGRESS.

Division of the subject—Examination of the question, Whether species have a real existence in nature?—Importance of this question in geology—Sketch of Lamarck's arguments in favor of the transmutation of species, and his conjectures respecting the origin of existing animals and plants—His theory of the transformation of the orang-outang into the human species.

Division of the topic—Exploration of the question, Do species actually exist in nature?—Significance of this question in geology—Overview of Lamarck's arguments supporting the transformation of species, and his ideas about the origins of current animals and plants—His theory on how the orangutan evolved into humans.

The last book, from chapters fourteen to thirty-three inclusive, was occupied with the consideration of the changes brought about on the earth's surface, within the period of human observation, by inorganic agents; such, for example, as rivers, marine currents, volcanoes, and earthquakes. But there is another class of phenomena relating to the organic world, which have an equal claim on our attention, if we desire to obtain possession of all the preparatory knowledge respecting the existing course of nature, which may be available in the interpretation of geological monuments. It appeared from our preliminary sketch of the progress of the science, that the most lively interest was excited among its earlier cultivators, by the discovery of the remains of animals and plants in the interior of mountains frequently remote from the sea. Much controversy arose respecting the nature of these remains, the causes which may have brought them into so singular a position, and the want of a specific agreement between them and known animals and plants. To qualify ourselves to form just views on these curious questions, we must first study the present condition of the animate creation on the globe.

The last book, from chapters fourteen to thirty-three inclusive, focused on the changes to the earth's surface that have occurred during human observation due to inorganic agents, such as rivers, ocean currents, volcanoes, and earthquakes. However, there’s another category of phenomena related to the organic world that equally deserves our attention if we want to gain a complete understanding of the current natural processes that can help us interpret geological formations. From our initial overview of the science’s development, it was clear that the discovery of animal and plant remains within mountains, often far from the ocean, sparked a great deal of interest among its early researchers. This led to significant debate about the nature of these remains, the reasons for their unusual positions, and the lack of direct relations to known animals and plants. To properly address these intriguing questions, we need to first examine the current state of living organisms on the planet.

This branch of our inquiry naturally divides itself into two parts: first, we may examine the vicissitudes to which species are subject; secondly, the processes by which certain individuals of these species occasionally become fossil. The first of these divisions will lead us, among other topics, to inquire, first, whether species have a real and permanent existence in nature? or whether they are capable, as some naturalists pretend, of being indefinitely modified in the course of a long series of generations? Secondly, whether, if species have a real existence, the individuals composing them have been derived originally from many similar stocks, or each from one only, the descendants of which have spread themselves gradually from a particular point over the habitable lands and waters? Thirdly, how far the duration of each species of animal and plant is limited by its dependence on certain fluctuating and temporary conditions in the state of the animate and inanimate world? Fourthly, whether there be proofs of the successive extermination of 567 species in the ordinary course of nature, and whether there be any reason for conjecturing that new animals and plants are created from time to time, to supply their place?

This part of our investigation is naturally split into two sections: first, we’ll look at the changes that species go through; second, we’ll explore how some individuals of these species sometimes become fossils. The first section will lead us to several questions, including: do species truly exist in nature permanently, or can they be endlessly changed through many generations, as some naturalists suggest? Next, if species do exist, did the individuals within them originally come from multiple similar ancestors, or just one, with their descendants gradually spreading from a specific point across the planet’s land and waters? Then, we’ll consider how much the lifespan of each species of plant and animal is affected by certain changing and temporary conditions in the living and non-living environment. Finally, we’ll ask if there’s evidence of the gradual extinction of 567 species in the natural course of events, and whether there’s any reason to think that new animals and plants are sometimes created to take their place.

Whether species have a real existence in nature.—Before we can advance a step in our proposed inquiry, we must be able to define precisely the meaning which we attach to the term species. This is even more necessary in geology than in the ordinary studies of the naturalist; for they who deny that such a thing as a species exists, concede nevertheless that a botanist or zoologist may reason as if the specific character were constant, because they confine their observations to a brief period of time. Just as the geographer, in constructing his maps from century to century, may proceed as if the apparent places of the fixed stars remained absolutely the same, and as if no alteration were brought about by the precession of the equinoxes; so, it is said, in the organic world, the stability of a species may be taken as absolute, if we do not extend our views beyond the narrow period of human history; but let a sufficient number of centuries elapse, to allow of important revolutions in climate, physical geography, and other circumstances, and the characters, say they, of the descendants of common parents may deviate indefinitely from their original type.

Whether species have a real existence in nature.—Before we can make any progress in our investigation, we need to clearly define what we mean by the term species. This is even more important in geology than in the typical studies of naturalists; because those who argue that species do not actually exist still admit that a botanist or zoologist can reason as if the specific characteristics were stable, since they limit their observations to a short timeframe. Just as a geographer, when creating maps over the centuries, can act as if the apparent positions of the fixed stars remain completely unchanged and that no shifts occur due to the precession of the equinoxes; similarly, it is suggested that in the organic world, the stability of a species can be viewed as absolute if we don’t look beyond the brief span of human history. However, if we allow enough centuries to pass for significant changes in climate, physical geography, and other factors, they argue, the traits of the descendants of common ancestors could vary significantly from their original form.

Now, if these doctrines be tenable, we are at once presented with a principle of incessant change in the organic world; and no degree of dissimilarity in the plants and animals which may formerly have existed, and are found fossil, would entitle us to conclude that they may not have been the prototypes and progenitors of the species now living. Accordingly M. Geoffroy St. Hilaire has declared his opinion, that there has been an uninterrupted succession in the animal kingdom, effected by means of generation, from the earliest ages of the world up to the present day, and that the ancient animals whose remains have been preserved in the strata, however different, may nevertheless have been the ancestors of those now in being. This notion is not very generally received, but we are not warranted in assuming the contrary, without fully explaining the data and reasoning by which it may be refuted.

Now, if these ideas hold true, we are immediately faced with a principle of constant change in the organic world; and no level of difference in the plants and animals that may have once existed and are now found as fossils would justify us in concluding that they couldn't have been the original forms and ancestors of the species that exist today. Consequently, M. Geoffroy St. Hilaire has expressed his belief that there has been a continuous succession in the animal kingdom, achieved through reproduction, from the earliest times until now, and that the ancient animals whose remains have been found in the layers of the earth, no matter how different, may still have been the ancestors of those that are alive today. This idea is not widely accepted, but we cannot assume the opposite without thoroughly explaining the evidence and reasoning that could refute it.

I shall begin by stating as concisely as possible all the facts and ingenious arguments by which the theory has been supported; and for this purpose I cannot do better than offer the reader a rapid sketch of Lamarck's statement of the proofs which he regards as confirmatory of the doctrine, and which he has derived partly from the works of his predecessors and in part from original investigations.

I will start by clearly outlining all the facts and clever arguments that support the theory. To do this, I will provide a quick overview of Lamarck's explanation of the evidence he believes backs the doctrine, which he has gathered partly from the works of those before him and partly from his own research.

His proofs and inferences will be best considered in the order in which they appear to have influenced his mind, and I shall then point out some of the results to which he was led while boldly following out his principles to their legitimate consequences.

His arguments and conclusions should be examined in the order that they seem to have shaped his thinking, and I will then highlight some of the outcomes he arrived at while confidently pursuing his principles to their logical conclusions.

Lamarck's arguments in favor of the transmutation of species.—The name of species, observes Lamarck, has been usually applied to "every collection of similar individuals produced by other individuals like themselves."790 568 This definition, he admits, is correct; because every living individual bears a very close resemblance to those from which it springs. But this is not all which is usually implied by the term species; for the majority of naturalists agree with Linnæus in supposing that all the individuals propagated from one stock have certain distinguishing characters in common, which will never vary, and which have remained the same since the creation of each species.

Lamarck's arguments for the change of species.—Lamarck notes that the term 'species' is usually used to refer to "any group of similar individuals produced by other similar individuals."790 568 He acknowledges that this definition is accurate; after all, every living individual closely resembles its ancestors. However, this is not the only idea typically associated with the term species. Most naturalists agree with Linnæus in believing that all individuals produced from a single lineage share specific distinguishing traits that do not change and have remained consistent since the creation of each species.

In order to shake this opinion, Lamarck enters upon the following line of argument:—The more we advance in the knowledge of the different organized bodies which cover the surface of the globe, the more our embarrassment increases, to determine what ought to be regarded as a species, and still more how to limit and distinguish genera. In proportion as our collections are enriched, we see almost every void filled up, and all our lines of separation effaced! We are reduced to arbitrary determinations, and are sometimes fain to seize upon the slight differences of mere varieties, in order to form characters for what we choose to call a species; and sometimes we are induced to pronounce individuals but slightly differing, and which others regard as true species, to be varieties.

To challenge this view, Lamarck presents the following argument: As we gain more knowledge about the various living organisms on Earth, we find it increasingly difficult to determine what should be classified as a species, and even more challenging to define and distinguish genera. As our collections grow, we notice that almost every gap gets filled, and the lines we've drawn between categories blur! We're left with arbitrary classifications and sometimes feel the need to latch onto minor differences among mere varieties to establish criteria for what we decide to call a species. At other times, we might consider individuals that others see as true species to be just varieties based on slight differences.

The greater the abundance of natural objects assembled together, the more do we discover proofs that every thing passes by insensible shades into something else; that even the more remarkable differences are evanescent, and that nature has, for the most part, left us nothing at our disposal for establishing distinctions, save trifling, and, in some respects, puerile particularities.

The more we gather natural objects together, the more we find evidence that everything transitions gradually into something else; even the most noticeable differences are temporary, and nature has mostly given us nothing to work with for making distinctions except minor and, in some ways, silly details.

We find that many genera amongst animals and plants are of such an extent, in consequence of the number of species referred to them, that the study and determination of these last has become almost impracticable. When the species are arranged in a series, and placed near to each other, with due regard to their natural affinities, they each differ in so minute a degree from those next adjoining, that they almost melt into each other, and are in a manner confounded together. If we see isolated species, we may presume the absence of some more closely connected, and which have not yet been discovered. Already are there genera, and even entire orders—nay, whole classes, which present an approximation to the state of things here indicated.

We notice that many groups of animals and plants are so large, due to the number of species included in them, that studying and identifying these species has become nearly impossible. When the species are lined up in a sequence and placed close to each other, considering their natural relationships, they differ so slightly from those next to them that they almost blend together and become hard to distinguish. If we encounter isolated species, we can assume that there are some closely related ones that haven’t been discovered yet. Already, there are groups, and even entire orders—indeed, whole classes—that show a similarity to the situation described here.

If, when species have been thus placed in a regular series, we select one, and then, making a leap over several intermediate ones, we take a second, at some distance from the first, these two will, on comparison, be seen to be very dissimilar; and it is in this manner that every naturalist begins to study the objects which are at his own door. He then finds it an easy task to establish generic and specific distinctions; and it is only when his experience is enlarged, and when he has made himself master of the intermediate links, that his difficulties and ambiguities begin. But while we are thus compelled to resort to trifling and minute characters in our attempt to separate the species, we find a striking disparity 569 between individuals which we know to have descended from a common stock; and these newly acquired peculiarities are regularly transmitted from one generation to another, constituting what are called races.

If we arrange species in a systematic order and then choose one, jumping over several others to take a second species that's a bit further away, these two will appear to be quite different when we compare them. This is how every naturalist starts studying the organisms around them. They quickly find it easy to define general and specific categories. It's only when they expand their knowledge and understand the species that connect them that they encounter challenges and confusion. However, while we have to focus on small and subtle details to distinguish between species, we observe a noticeable difference between individuals that we know share a common ancestor. These newly acquired traits are consistently passed down through generations, forming what we call races. 569

From a great number of facts, continues the author, we learn that in proportion as the individuals of one of our species change their situation, climate, and manner of living, they change also, by little and little, the consistence and proportions of their parts, their form, their faculties, and even their organization, in such a manner that every thing in them comes at last to participate in the mutations to which they have been exposed. Even in the same climate, a great difference of situation and exposure causes individuals to vary; but if these individuals continue to live and to be reproduced under the same difference of circumstances, distinctions are brought about in them which become in some degree essential to their existence. In a word, at the end of many successive generations, these individuals, which originally belonged to another species, are transformed into a new and distinct species.791

From a wide range of facts, the author continues, we learn that as individuals of our species change their environment, climate, and lifestyle, they gradually alter the consistency and proportions of their parts, their shape, their abilities, and even their organization, so that everything about them ultimately reflects the changes they have experienced. Even in the same climate, significant differences in location and exposure cause individuals to vary; but if these individuals continue to live and reproduce under the same differing circumstances, distinct characteristics develop that become somewhat essential to their existence. In short, after many successive generations, these individuals, which originally belonged to a different species, transform into a new and distinct species.791

Thus, for example, if the seeds of a grass, or any other plant which grows naturally in a moist meadow, be accidentally transported, first to the slope of some neighboring hill, where the soil, although at a greater elevation, is damp enough to allow the plant to live; and if, after having lived there, and having been several times regenerated, it reaches by degrees the drier and almost arid soil of a mountain declivity, it will then, if it succeeds in growing, and perpetuates itself for a series of generations, be so changed that botanists who meet with it will regard it as a particular species.792 The unfavorable climate in this case, deficiency of nourishment, exposure to the winds, and other causes, give rise to a stunted and dwarfish race, with some organ more developed than others, and having proportions often quite peculiar.

So, for example, if the seeds of a grass or any other plant that naturally grows in a moist meadow are accidentally moved to the slope of a nearby hill, where the soil is damp enough to support the plant's life even though it's at a higher elevation; and if, after surviving there and regenerating several times, it gradually makes its way to the drier, almost barren soil of a mountain slope, then, if it manages to grow and reproduce over several generations, it will be so altered that botanists who encounter it will see it as a distinct species.792 The challenging climate in this situation—lack of nutrients, exposure to wind, and other factors—results in a stunted and undersized variety, with some features more developed than others, and proportions that are often quite unique.

What nature brings about in a great lapse of time, we occasion suddenly by changing the circumstances in which a species has been accustomed to live. All are aware that vegetables taken from their birthplace, and cultivated in gardens, undergo changes which render them no longer recognizable as the same plants. Many which were naturally hairy become smooth, or nearly so; a great number of such as were creepers and trailed along the ground, rear their stalks and grow erect. Others lose their thorns or asperities; others, again, from the ligneous state which their stem possessed in hot climates, where they were indigenous, pass to the herbaceous; and, among them, some which were perennials become mere annuals. So well do botanists know the effects of such changes of circumstances, that they are averse to describe species from garden specimens, unless they are sure that they have been cultivated for a very short period.

What nature accomplishes over a long period, we can achieve quickly by changing the conditions in which a species has adapted to live. Everyone knows that plants taken from their natural habitat and grown in gardens undergo changes that make them no longer recognizable as the same species. Many plants that were naturally hairy become smooth, or nearly so; many that used to creep along the ground stand tall and grow upright. Others lose their thorns or roughness; still others, which were woody in hot climates where they originated, become herbaceous; and some perennials turn into annuals. Botanists are so familiar with the effects of these changes in conditions that they avoid describing species based on garden specimens unless they are certain they have been cultivated for a very short time.

"Is not the cultivated wheat" (Triticum sativum), asks Lamarck, "a vegetable brought by man into the state in which we now see it? Let 570 any one tell me in what country a similar plant grows wild, unless where it has escaped from cultivated fields? Where do we find in nature our cabbages, lettuces, and other culinary vegetables, in the state in which they appear in our gardens? Is it not the same in regard to a great quantity of animals which domesticity has changed or considerably modified?"793 Our domestic fowls and pigeons are unlike any wild birds. Our domestic ducks and geese have lost the faculty of raising themselves into the higher regions of the air, and crossing extensive countries in their flight, like the wild ducks and wild geese from which they were originally derived. A bird which we breed in a cage cannot, when restored to liberty, fly like others of the same species which have been always free. This small alteration of circumstances, however, has only diminished the power of flight, without modifying the form of any part of the wings. But when individuals of the same race are retained in captivity during a considerable length of time, the form even of their parts is gradually made to differ, especially if climate, nourishment, and other circumstances be also altered.

"Isn't cultivated wheat" (Triticum sativum), asks Lamarck, "a plant that humans have brought to the state we see it in now? Can anyone tell me where a similar plant grows wild, unless it has escaped from cultivated fields? Where do we find in nature our cabbages, lettuces, and other vegetables in the form they take in our gardens? Isn't it the same with many animals that domestication has changed or significantly altered?"793 Our domestic chickens and pigeons are different from any wild birds. Our domestic ducks and geese have lost the ability to soar high in the sky and travel long distances like the wild ducks and geese they came from. A bird that we raise in a cage cannot fly like others of the same species that have always been free when it is set free. This slight change in circumstances has only reduced the power of flight without altering the structure of any part of the wings. However, when individuals of the same species are kept in captivity for a long time, the shape of their body parts gradually starts to change, especially if factors like climate, diet, and other conditions are also modified.

The numerous races of dogs which we have produced by domesticity are nowhere to be found in a wild state. In nature we should seek in vain for mastiffs, harriers, spaniels, greyhounds, and other races, between which the differences are sometimes so great that they would be readily admitted as specific between wild animals; "yet all these have sprung originally from a single race, at first approaching very near to a wolf, if, indeed, the wolf be not the true type which at some period or other was domesticated by man."

The many breeds of dogs we've created through domestication don't exist in the wild. In nature, we would look in vain for mastiffs, harriers, spaniels, greyhounds, and other breeds, which differ so much that they would easily be considered different species among wild animals. "Yet all these have originally come from a single breed, which was initially very similar to a wolf, if, in fact, the wolf isn't the true type that was domesticated by humans at some point."

Although important changes in the nature of the places which they inhabit modify the organization of animals as well as vegetables; yet the former, says Lamarck, require more time to complete a considerable degree of transmutation; and, consequently, we are less sensible of such occurrences. Next to a diversity of the medium in which animals or plants may live, the circumstances which have most influence in modifying their organs are differences in exposure, climate, the nature of the soil, and other local particulars. These circumstances are as varied as are the characters of the species, and, like them, pass by insensible shades into each other, there being every intermediate gradation between the opposite extremes. But each locality remains for a very long time the same, and is altered so slowly that we can only become conscious of the reality of the change by consulting geological monuments, by which we learn that the order of things which how reigns in each place has not always prevailed, and by inference anticipate that it will not always continue the same.794

Even though significant changes in the environments where they live alter the organization of both animals and plants, Lamarck notes that animals take longer to undergo noticeable transformations, making these changes less apparent to us. Besides the variation in the environment where animals or plants exist, the factors that most affect their physical features include differences in exposure, climate, soil type, and other local specifics. These factors are as diverse as the characteristics of the species and blend into one another in subtle ways, with every gradation existing between the two extremes. However, each area remains quite stable for a long time and changes so slowly that we can only recognize the reality of these changes by examining geological records, which reveal that the current state of each place hasn't always been the same, leading us to infer that it won't remain unchanged forever.794

Every considerable alteration in the local circumstances in which each race of animals exists causes a change in their wants, and these new wants excite them to new actions and habits. These actions require the more frequent employment of some parts before but slightly exercised, 571 and then greater development follows as a consequence of their more frequent use. Other organs no longer in use are impoverished and diminished in size, nay, are sometimes entirely annihilated, while in their place new parts are insensibly produced for the discharge of new functions.795

Every significant change in the local conditions where different animal species live leads to a change in their needs, and these new needs drive them to adopt new behaviors and habits. These behaviors require more frequent use of certain parts that were previously used only a little, and as a result, those parts develop more from being used more often. Other parts that are no longer used become weakened and shrink in size, and sometimes they even disappear entirely, while new parts gradually emerge to fulfill new roles.

I must here interrupt the author's argument, by observing, that no positive fact is cited to exemplify the substitution of some entirely new sense, faculty, or organ, in the room of some other suppressed as useless. All the instances adduced go only to prove that the dimensions and strength of members and the perfection of certain attributes may, in a long succession of generations, be lessened and enfeebled by disuse; or, on the contrary, be matured and augmented by active exertion; just as we know that the power of scent is feeble in the greyhound, while its swiftness of pace and its acuteness of sight are remarkable—that the harrier and stag-hound, on the contrary, are comparatively slow in their movements, but excel in the sense of smelling.

I need to pause the author's argument to point out that no concrete examples are provided to demonstrate the replacement of some entirely new sense, ability, or organ for another one that has been deemed useless. All the examples given only show that the size and strength of body parts and the quality of certain traits can diminish and weaken over many generations due to disuse; or, on the other hand, can develop and enhance through active use. For instance, we see that a greyhound has a weak sense of smell, but it is notable for its speed and keen eyesight—whereas the harrier and stag-hound, while slower, excel in their sense of smell.

It was necessary to point out to the reader this important chasm in the chain of evidence, because he might otherwise imagine that I had merely omitted the illustrations for the sake of brevity; but the plain truth is, that there were no examples to be found; and when Lamarck talks "of the efforts of internal sentiment," "the influence of subtle fluids," and "acts of organization," as causes whereby animals and plants may acquire new organs, he substitutes names for things; and, with a disregard to the strict rules of induction, resorts to fictions, as ideal as the "plastic virtue," and other phantoms of the geologists of the middle ages.

It was important to highlight this significant gap in the evidence chain for the reader since they might otherwise think I just left out the examples to keep things short. But the truth is, there were no examples available. When Lamarck refers to "the efforts of internal sentiment," "the influence of subtle fluids," and "acts of organization" as reasons why animals and plants might develop new organs, he’s just using labels instead of concrete concepts; and by ignoring strict rules of induction, he relies on ideas as unrealistic as the "plastic virtue" and other fanciful notions from medieval geologists.

It is evident that, if some well-authenticated facts could have been adduced to establish one complete step in the process of transformation, such as the appearance, in individuals descending from a common stock, of a sense or organ entirely new, and a complete disappearance of some other enjoyed by their progenitors, time alone might then be supposed sufficient to bring about any amount of metamorphosis. The gratuitous assumption, therefore, of a point so vital to the theory of transmutation, was unpardonable on the part of its advocate.

It’s clear that if some well-documented facts could have been offered to prove a complete step in the process of transformation, like the emergence of a completely new sense or organ in individuals coming from a common ancestor, along with the total disappearance of some organ that their ancestors had, then time alone might be considered enough to create any level of change. Therefore, the unfounded assumption of such a crucial point for the theory of evolution was inexcusable on the part of its supporter.

But to proceed with the system: it being assumed as an undoubted fact, that a change of external circumstances may cause one organ to become entirely obsolete, and a new one to be developed, such as never before belonged to the species, the following proposition is announced, which, however staggering and absurd it may seem, is logically deduced from the assumed premises. It is not the organs, or, in other words, the nature and form of the parts of the body of an animal, which have given rise to its habits, and its particular faculties; but, on the contrary, its habits, its manner of living, and those of its progenitors, have in the course of time determined the form of its body, the number and condition of its organs—in short, the faculties which it enjoys. Thus otters, 572 beavers, waterfowl, turtles, and frogs, were not made web-footed in order that they might swim; but their wants having attracted them to the water in search of prey, they stretched out the toes of their feet to strike the water and move rapidly along its surface. By the repeated stretching of their toes, the skin which united them at the base acquired a habit of extension, until, in the course of time, the broad membranes which now connect their extremities were formed.

But to continue with the system: it is taken as a given that changes in external circumstances can make one organ completely obsolete while leading to the development of a new one that the species has never had before. The following statement is put forward, which, although it may seem shocking and ridiculous, is logically derived from the stated assumptions. It's not the organs, or in other words, the nature and shape of an animal's body parts, that have shaped its habits and specific abilities; rather, its habits, lifestyle, and those of its ancestors have, over time, influenced the form of its body, the number and condition of its organs—in short, the abilities it possesses. So, otters, 572 beavers, waterfowl, turtles, and frogs were not designed with webbed feet to swim; instead, their needs led them to the water in search of food, and they evolved their toes to strike the water and move quickly along its surface. Through repeatedly stretching their toes, the skin connecting them at the base became accustomed to extension, until, over time, the broad membranes that now link their extremities formed.

In like manner, the antelope and the gazelle were not endowed with light agile forms, in order that they might escape by flight from carnivorous animals; but, having been exposed to the danger of being devoured by lions, tigers, and other beasts of prey, they were compelled to exert themselves in running with great celerity; a habit which, in the course of many generations, gave rise to the peculiar slenderness of their legs, and the agility and elegance of their forms.

Similarly, the antelope and the gazelle didn’t develop their light, agile bodies just to escape from predators; instead, facing the threat of being hunted by lions, tigers, and other carnivores, they had to run really fast. Over many generations, this necessity led to the unique slenderness of their legs and the agility and grace of their bodies.

The camelopard was not gifted with a long flexible neck because it was destined to live in the interior of Africa, where the soil was arid and devoid of herbage; but, being reduced by the nature of that country to support itself on the foliage of lofty trees, it contracted a habit of stretching itself up to reach the high boughs, until its neck became so elongated that it could raise its head to the height of twenty feet above the ground.

The giraffe didn’t get its long, flexible neck because it was meant to live in the arid interiors of Africa, where the land had little vegetation. Instead, adapting to the environment where it needed to feed on the leaves of tall trees, it developed the habit of stretching up to reach the high branches, resulting in its neck becoming so long that it could lift its head to a height of twenty feet above the ground.

Another line of argument is then entered upon, in farther corroboration of the instability of species. In order, it is said, that individuals should perpetuate themselves unaltered by generation, those belonging to one species ought never to ally themselves to those of another; but such sexual unions do take place, both among plants and animals; and although the offspring of such irregular connections are usually sterile, yet such is not always the case. Hybrids have sometimes proved prolific, where the disparity between the species was not too great; and by this means alone, says Lamarck, varieties may gradually be created by near alliances, which would become races, and in the course of time would constitute what we term species.796

Another argument is presented to further support the idea that species are unstable. It’s said that for individuals to reproduce unchanged, those in one species should never mate with those in another. However, such mating does occur, both in plants and animals; and while the offspring from these irregular unions are usually sterile, that’s not always the case. Hybrids can sometimes reproduce successfully if the species aren’t too different from each other, and through this process, Lamarck argues, varieties can slowly emerge from close relationships, eventually becoming races, and over time, what we recognize as species.796

But if the soundness of all these arguments and inferences be admitted, we are next to inquire, what were the original types of form, organization, and instinct, from which the diversities of character, as now exhibited by animals and plants, have been derived? We know that individuals which are mere varieties of the same species would, if their pedigree could be traced back far enough, terminate in a single stock; so, according to the train of reasoning before described, the species of a genus, and even the genera of a great family, must have had a common point of departure. What, then, was the single stem from which so many varieties of form have ramified? Were there many of these, or are we to refer the origin of the whole animate creation, as the Egyptian priests did that of the universe, to a single egg?

But if we accept the validity of all these arguments and conclusions, we should next consider what the original types of form, organization, and instinct were that led to the variety of characteristics we see in animals and plants today. We understand that individuals that are just varieties of the same species would, if we could trace their lineage far enough back, ultimately lead to a single ancestor; thus, following the reasoning we've discussed, the species within a genus and even the genera within a larger family must have originated from a common source. So, what was the one stem from which so many different forms have branched out? Were there multiple origins, or should we, like the Egyptian priests regarding the universe, attribute the beginning of all living creation to a single egg?

573 In the absence of any positive data for framing a theory on so obscure a subject, the following considerations were deemed of importance to guide conjecture.

573 Without any solid information to shape a theory on such a unclear topic, the following thoughts were considered important to direct speculation.

In the first place, if we examine the whole series of known animals, from one extremity to the other, when they are arranged in the order of their natural relations, we find that we may pass progressively, or, at least, with very few interruptions, from beings of more simple to those of a more compound structure; and, in proportion as the complexity of their organization increases, the number and dignity of their faculties increase also. Among plants, a similar approximation to a graduated scale of being is apparent, Secondly, it appears, from geological observations, that plants and animals of more simple organization existed on the globe before the appearance of those of more compound structure, and the latter were successively formed at more modern periods; each new race being more fully developed than the most perfect of the preceding era.

In the first place, if we look at the entire range of known animals, from one end to the other, when they are organized according to their natural relationships, we see that we can gradually move, with very few interruptions, from simpler beings to those with a more complex structure. As the complexity of their organization increases, so do the number and importance of their abilities. A similar progression can be seen among plants. Secondly, geological observations indicate that simpler plants and animals existed on Earth before more complex ones appeared, and that the latter were formed in more recent time periods, with each new species being more developed than the most advanced species of the previous era.

Of the truth of the last-mentioned geological theory, Lamarck seems to have been fully persuaded; and he also shows that he was deeply impressed with a belief prevalent amongst the older naturalists, that the primeval ocean invested the whole planet long after it became the habitation of living beings; and thus he was inclined to assert the priority of the types of marine animals to those of the terrestrial, so as to fancy, for example, that the testacea of the ocean existed first, until some of them, by gradual evolution, were improved into those inhabiting the land.

Lamarck appears to have been completely convinced of the validity of the geological theory mentioned earlier. He was also significantly influenced by a belief common among earlier naturalists that the primordial ocean covered the entire planet long after it became home to living creatures. Because of this, he tended to argue that marine animals came before terrestrial ones, thinking, for instance, that ocean-dwelling shellfish existed first, and that over time, some of them gradually evolved into those living on land.

These speculative views had already been, in a great degree, anticipated by Demaillet in his Telliamed, and by several modern writers; so that the tables were completely turned on the philosophers of antiquity, with whom it was a received maxim, that created things were always most perfect when they came first from the hands of their Maker; and that there was a tendency to progressive deterioration in sublunary things when left to themselves—

These speculative ideas had already been largely anticipated by Demaillet in his Telliamed, and by several modern writers; so the tables were completely turned on the philosophers of ancient times, who believed that created things were always at their best when they first came from the hands of their Creator, and that there was a tendency for things on earth to gradually get worse when left to their own devices—

all things destined To fall into worse circumstances and be pulled back down again.

So deeply was the faith of the ancient schools of philosophy imbued with this dóctrine, that, to check this universal proneness to degeneracy, nothing less than the reintervention of the Deity was thought adequate; and it was held, that thereby the order, excellence, and pristine energy of the moral and physical world had been repeatedly restored.

So deeply was the faith of the ancient schools of philosophy infused with this doctrine that, to curb this widespread tendency toward decline, nothing less than the intervention of God was deemed sufficient; it was believed that through this, the order, excellence, and original vitality of both the moral and physical world had been repeatedly restored.

But when the possibility of the indefinite modification of individuals descending from common parents was once assumed, as also the geological inference respecting the progressive development of organic life, it was natural that the ancient dogma should be rejected, or rather reversed, and that the most simple and imperfect forms and faculties should be conceived to have been the originals whence all others were developed. Accordingly, in conformity to these views, inert matter was supposed to have been first endowed with life; until, in the course of ages, sensation 574 was superadded to mere vitality: sight, hearing, and the other senses were afterwards acquired; then instinct and the mental faculties; until, finally, by virtue of the tendency of things to progressive improvement, the irrational was developed in the rational.

But when people started to accept the idea that individuals could change indefinitely from shared ancestors, along with the geological theory of how life on Earth evolved over time, it made sense to dismiss or even overturn the old belief. Instead, the idea emerged that the simplest and most basic forms and abilities were the originals from which all others evolved. Thus, in line with these ideas, it was thought that lifeless matter was first given life; then, over the ages, the ability to feel was added to just having life: sight, hearing, and the other senses were developed next; then instinct and mental abilities appeared; and finally, due to the natural tendency towards progressive improvement, the irrational was transformed into the rational.

The reader, however, will immediately perceive that when all the higher orders of plants and animals were thus supposed to be comparatively modern, and to have been derived in a long series of generations from those of more simple conformation, some farther hypothesis became indispensable, in order to explain why, after an indefinite lapse of ages, there were still so many beings of the simplest structure. Why have the majority of existing creatures remained stationary throughout this long succession of epochs, while others have made such prodigious advances? Why are there such multitudes of infusoria and polyps, or of confervæ and other cryptogamic plants? Why, moreover, has the process of development acted with such unequal and irregular force on those classes of beings which have been greatly perfected, so that there are wide chasms in the series; gaps so enormous, that Lamarck fairly admits we can never expect to fill them up by future discoveries?

The reader will quickly notice that if all the higher plants and animals are viewed as relatively modern and have evolved over a long series of generations from simpler forms, then an additional explanation is necessary. This is to address why, despite the passage of countless ages, there are still so many organisms with the simplest structures. Why have most existing creatures stayed the same throughout this long period, while others have made incredible progress? Why are there so many infusoria and polyps, or confervae and other types of cryptogamic plants? Moreover, why has the development process operated with such uneven and inconsistent strength on those groups of beings that have evolved significantly, leading to such large gaps in the evolutionary chain—gaps so vast that Lamarck openly admits we can never expect to bridge them with future discoveries?

The following hypothesis was provided to meet these objections. Nature, we are told, is not an intelligence, nor the Deity; but a delegated power—a mere instrument—a piece of mechanism acting by necessity—an order of things constituted by the Supreme Being, and subject to laws which are the expressions of his will. This Nature is obliged to proceed gradually in all her operations; she cannot produce animals and plants of all classes at once, but must always begin by the formation of the most simple kinds, and out of them elaborate the more compound, adding to them, successively, different systems of organs, and multiplying more and more their number and energy.

The following hypothesis was presented to address these objections. We're told that nature isn't an intelligence or a deity; rather, it's a delegated power—a mere tool—a piece of machinery operating out of necessity—an arrangement created by the Supreme Being, governed by laws that reflect his will. This nature is required to proceed gradually in all her processes; she cannot produce all types of animals and plants at once but must always start with the simplest forms and then develop the more complex ones, successively adding different systems of organs and increasing their quantity and vitality.

This nature is daily engaged in the formation of the elementary rudiments of animal and vegetable existence, which correspond to what the ancients termed spontaneous generation. She is always beginning anew, day by day, the work of creation, by forming monads, or "rough draughts" (ébauches), which are the only living things she gives birth to directly.

This nature is constantly involved in creating the basic building blocks of animal and plant life, which the ancients referred to as spontaneous generation. She is always starting over, day after day, the work of creation by producing monads, or "rough drafts" (ébauches), which are the only living things she brings into existence directly.

There are distinct primary rudiments of plants and animals, and probably of each of the great divisions of the animal and vegetable kingdoms.797 These are gradually developed into the higher and more perfect classes by the slow but unceasing agency of two influential principles: first, the tendency to progressive advancement in organization, accompanied by greater dignity in instinct, intelligence, &c.; secondly, the force of external circumstances, or of variations in the physical condition of the earth, or the mutual relations of plants and animals. For, as species spread themselves gradually over the globe, they are exposed from time to time to variations in climate, and to changes in the quantity and quality of their food; they meet with new plants and animals which 575 assist or retard their development, by supplying them with nutriment, or destroying their foes. The nature, also, of each locality, is in itself fluctuating; so that, even if the relation of other animals and plants were invariable, the habits and organization of species would be modified by the influence of local revolutions.

There are distinct basic elements of plants and animals, and probably of each of the major divisions of the animal and plant kingdoms.797 These develop gradually into the higher and more advanced classes through the slow but constant influence of two key principles: first, the tendency to progress in structure, along with greater sophistication in instinct, intelligence, etc.; and second, the impact of external factors, or variations in the Earth's physical conditions, or the relationships between plants and animals. As species gradually spread across the globe, they occasionally face changes in climate and variations in the quantity and quality of their food; they encounter new plants and animals that either help or hinder their development by providing nourishment or eliminating their enemies. Additionally, the nature of each location is itself variable; so, even if the relationships among other animals and plants were constant, the habits and structures of species would still change due to the impact of local events.

Now, if the first of these principles, the tendency to progressive development, were left to exert itself with perfect freedom, it would give rise, says Lamarck, in the course of ages, to a graduated scale of being, where the most insensible transition might be traced from the simplest to the most compound structure, from the humblest to the most exalted degree of intelligence. But, in consequence of the perpetual interference of the external causes before mentioned, this regular order is greatly interfered with, and an approximation only to such a state of things is exhibited by the animate creation, the progress of some races being retarded by unfavorable, and that of others accelerated by favorable, combinations of circumstances. Hence, all kinds of anomalies interrupt the continuity of the plan; and chasms, into which whole genera or families might be inserted, are seen to separate the nearest existing portions of the series.

Now, if the first of these principles, the tendency to progressive development, were allowed to operate completely freely, it would lead, according to Lamarck, over time, to a graduated scale of being, where the most subtle transitions could be seen from the simplest to the most complex structures, from the lowest to the highest levels of intelligence. However, due to the constant interference of the external causes mentioned earlier, this orderly progression is significantly disrupted, and only a rough approximation of such a state of affairs is presented by living beings, with the progress of some species being hindered by unfavorable conditions, while that of others is sped up by favorable circumstances. As a result, various anomalies disrupt the continuity of the plan, and gaps, into which entire genera or families could fit, are evident between the closest existing parts of the series.

Lamarck's theory of the transformation of the orang-outang into the human species.—Such is the machinery of the Lamarckian system; but the reader will hardly, perhaps, be able to form a perfect conception of so complicated a piece of mechanism, unless it is exhibited in motion, so that we may see in what manner it can work out, under the author's guidance, all the extraordinary effects which we behold in the present state of the animate creation. I have only space for exhibiting a small part of the entire process by which a complete metamorphosis is achieved, and shall therefore omit the mode by which, after a countless succession of generations, a small gelatinous body is transformed into an oak or an ape; passing on at once to the last grand step in the progressive scheme, by which the orang-outang, having been already evolved out of a monad, is made slowly to attain the attributes and dignity of man.

Lamarck's theory of how the orangutan evolved into humans.—This is the machinery of the Lamarckian system; however, the reader might struggle to fully grasp such a complex piece of machinery unless it's displayed in action, allowing us to see how it can produce, under the author's guidance, all the remarkable outcomes we observe in the current state of living beings. I only have room to show a small part of the whole process by which a complete transformation occurs, so I will skip over the method by which, after countless generations, a small gelatinous body is turned into an oak or an ape; instead, I will jump directly to the final significant step in the progressive scheme, wherein the orangutan, having already evolved from a monad, gradually develops the qualities and stature of a human.

One of the races of quadrumanous animals which had reached the highest state of perfection, lost, by constraint of circumstances (concerning the exact nature of which tradition is unfortunately silent), the habit of climbing trees, and of hanging on by grasping the boughs with their feet as with hands. The individuals of this race being obliged, for a long series of generations, to use their feet exclusively for walking, and ceasing to employ their hands as feet, were transformed into bimanous animals, and what before were thumbs became mere toes, no separation being required when their feet were used solely for walking. Having acquired a habit of holding themselves upright, their legs and feet assumed, insensibly, a conformation fitted to support them in an erect attitude, till at last these animals could no longer go on all-fours without much inconvenience.

One of the species of four-handed animals, which had evolved to the highest level of development, lost, due to circumstances (the exact nature of which tradition unfortunately fails to clarify), the ability to climb trees and hang on by grasping branches with their feet like hands. Because individuals of this species were compelled, over many generations, to use their feet solely for walking and stopped using their hands as feet, they transformed into two-handed animals, and what were once thumbs became just toes, with no distinction needed when their feet were used only for walking. As they became accustomed to standing upright, their legs and feet gradually changed shape to better support them in an upright position, until eventually these animals found it quite difficult to move on all fours without significant discomfort.

The Angola orang (Simia troglodytes, Linn.) is the most perfect of 576 animals; much more so than the Indian orang (Simia Satyrus), which has been called the orang-outang, although both are very inferior to man in corporeal powers and intelligence. These animals frequently hold themselves upright; but their organization has not yet been sufficiently modified to sustain them habitually in this attitude, so that the standing posture is very uneasy to them. When the Indian orang is compelled to take flight from pressing danger, he immediately falls down upon all-fours, showing clearly that this was the original position of the animal. Even in man, whose organization, in the course of a long series of generations, has advanced so much farther, the upright posture is fatiguing, and can be supported only for a limited time, and by aid of the contraction of many muscles. If the vertebral column formed the axis of the human body, and supported the head and all the other parts in equilibrium, then might the upright position be a state of repose: but, as the human head does not articulate in the centre of gravity, as the chest, belly, and other parts press almost entirely forward with their whole weight, and as the vertebral column reposes upon an oblique base, a watchful activity is required to prevent the body from falling. Children who have large heads and prominent bellies can hardly walk at the end even of two years; and their frequent tumbles indicate the natural tendency in man to resume the quadrupedal state.

The Angola orangutan (Simia troglodytes, Linn.) is the most advanced of 576 animals; much more so than the Indian orangutan (Simia Satyrus), which has been called the orangutan, although both are far inferior to humans in physical abilities and intelligence. These animals often stand upright; however, their bodies haven’t been changed enough to support this position comfortably, making it quite uncomfortable for them. When the Indian orangutan is forced to escape from immediate danger, it quickly falls on all fours, clearly showing that this was how the animal originally moved. Even in humans, whose bodies have evolved much further over many generations, standing upright can be tiring and can only be maintained for a period of time with the help of various muscle contractions. If the spine were the central support of the body, enabling the head and all other parts to balance easily, then standing could be a restful position. But since the human head doesn't align perfectly with the center of gravity, and since the chest, abdomen, and other parts lean forward with their full weight, maintaining balance requires constant effort to prevent falling. Children with large heads and prominent bellies struggle to walk even after two years, and their frequent falls show the inherent tendency in humans to revert to moving on all fours.

Now, when so much progress had been made by the quadrumanous animals before mentioned, that they could hold themselves habitually in an erect attitude, and were accustomed to a wide range of vision, and ceased to use their jaws for fighting and tearing, or for clipping herbs for food, their snout became gradually shorter, their incisor teeth became vertical, and the facial angle grew more open.

Now, when the four-handed animals mentioned earlier had made significant progress, allowing them to regularly stand upright and enjoy a broad field of vision, and when they stopped using their jaws for fighting, tearing, or cutting plants for food, their snouts slowly became shorter, their front teeth stood upright, and the angle of their face became more pronounced.

Among other ideas which the natural tendency to perfection engendered, the desire of ruling suggested itself, and this race succeeded at length in getting the better of the other animals, and made themselves masters of all those spots on the surface of the globe which best suited them. They drove out the animals which approached nearest them in organization and intelligence, and which were in a condition to dispute with them the good things of this world, forcing them to take refuge in deserts, woods, and wildernesses, where their multiplication was checked, and the progressive development of their faculties retarded; while, in the mean time, the dominant race spread itself in every direction, and lived in large companies, where new wants were successively created, exciting them to industry, and gradually perfecting their means and faculties.

Among other ideas that the natural tendency to perfection generated, the desire to rule emerged, and this race eventually overcame the other animals, becoming the masters of all the places on Earth that suited them best. They drove out the animals that were closest to them in organization and intelligence, those that could compete with them for the resources of this world, forcing them to seek refuge in deserts, forests, and wild areas, where their numbers were limited and the development of their abilities was slowed down. Meanwhile, the dominant race expanded in every direction and lived in large groups, where new needs continually arose, motivating them to work hard and gradually improving their abilities and resources.

In the supremacy and increased intelligence acquired by the ruling race, we see an illustration of the natural tendency of the organic world to grow more perfect; and, in their influence in repressing the advance of others, an example of one of those disturbing causes before enumerated, that force of external circumstances which causes such wide chasms in the regular series of animated being.

In the dominance and heightened intelligence of the ruling race, we see an example of the natural tendency in the organic world to evolve towards greater perfection; and, in their role in hindering the progress of others, a clear instance of one of the previously mentioned disruptive factors, that force of external circumstances which creates significant gaps in the normal progression of living beings.

577 When the individuals of the dominant race became very numerous, their ideas greatly increased in number, and they felt the necessity of communicating them to each other, and of augmenting and varying the signs proper for the communication of ideas. Meanwhile the inferior quadrumanous animals, although most of them were gregarious, acquired no new ideas, being persecuted and restless in the deserts, and obliged to fly and conceal themselves, so that they conceived no new wants. Such ideas as they already had remained unaltered, and they could dispense with the communication of the greater part of these. To make themselves, therefore, understood by their fellows, required merely a few movements of the body or limbs—whistling, and the uttering of certain cries varied by the inflexions of the voice.

577 As the members of the dominant race grew in number, their ideas increased significantly, and they felt the need to share these ideas with one another, as well as expand and diversify the ways to communicate them. Meanwhile, the lesser primates, although many of them lived in groups, did not develop any new ideas. They were oppressed and restless in their habitats, forced to flee and hide, which meant they didn’t formulate new needs. The ideas they already had stayed the same, and they could get by without communicating most of them. To express themselves to each other, they just needed a few body movements or gestures—whistling and making various cries, with changes in tone of voice.

On the contrary, the individuals of the ascendant race, animated with a desire of interchanging their ideas, which became more and more numerous, were prompted to multiply the means of communication, and were no longer satisfied with mere pantomimic signs, nor even with all the possible inflexions of the voice, but made continual efforts to acquire the power of uttering articulate sounds, employing a few at first, but afterwards varying and perfecting them according to the increase of their wants. The habitual exercise of their throat, tongue, and lips, insensibly modified the conformation of these organs, until they became fitted for the faculty of speech.798

On the contrary, the people of the dominant race, driven by a desire to share their ideas, which kept growing in number, were encouraged to expand their means of communication. They were no longer satisfied with just gestures or even the various tones of voice; instead, they continually worked to develop the ability to speak clearly. They started with a few sounds, but over time, they varied and improved them as their needs grew. The regular use of their throat, tongue, and lips gradually changed the shape of these organs until they were suited for speech.798

In effecting this mighty change, "the exigencies of the individuals were the sole agents; they gave rise to efforts, and the organs proper for articulating sounds were developed by their habitual employment." Hence, in this peculiar race, the origin of the admirable faculty of speech; hence also the diversity of languages, since the distance of places where the individuals composing the race established themselves soon favored the corruption of conventional signs.799

In making this significant change, "the needs of individuals were the only driving forces; they led to efforts, and the parts needed to produce sounds were developed through regular use." Therefore, in this unique group, we find the origin of the remarkable ability to speak; and this also explains the variety of languages, as the distances between where the individuals of the group settled contributed to the distortion of shared symbols.799

In conclusion, it may be proper to observe that the above sketch of the Lamarckian theory is no exaggerated picture, and those passages which have probably excited the greatest surprise in the mind of the reader are literal translations from the original.

In conclusion, it should be noted that the above summary of the Lamarckian theory is not an exaggerated portrayal, and those sections that likely surprised the reader the most are direct translations from the original.


CHAPTER XXXIV.

TRANSMUTATION OF SPECIES—Continued.

Recapitulation of the arguments in favor of the theory of transmutation of species—Their insufficiency—Causes of difficulty in discriminating species—Some varieties possibly more distinct than certain individuals of distinct species—Variability in a species consistent with a belief that the limits of deviation are fixed—No facts of transmutation authenticated—Varieties of the Dog—the Dog and Wolf distinct species—Mummies of various animals from Egypt identical in character with living individuals—Seeds and plants from the Egyptian tombs—Modifications produced in plants by agriculture and gardening.

Recap of the arguments supporting the theory of species transmutation—Their inadequacy—Reasons for the challenges in identifying species—Some varieties may be more distinct than some individuals of different species—Variability within a species can align with the belief that the boundaries of change are set—No verified instances of transmutation—Different breeds of dogs—the dog and wolf are distinct species—Mummies of various animals from Egypt are identical to living ones—Seeds and plants found in Egyptian tombs—Changes in plants due to farming and gardening.

The theory of the transmutation of species, considered in the last chapter, has met with some degree of favor from many naturalists, from their desire to dispense, as far as possible, with the repeated intervention of a First Cause, as often as geological monuments attest the successive appearance of new races of animals and plants, and the extinction of those pre-existing. But, independently of a predisposition to account, if possible, for a series of changes in the organic world by the regular action of secondary causes, we have seen that in truth many perplexing difficulties present themselves to one who attempts to establish the nature and reality of the specific character. And if once there appears ground of reasonable doubt, in regard to the constancy of species, the amount of transformation which they are capable of undergoing may seem to resolve itself into a mere question of the quantity of time assigned to the past duration of animate existence.

The theory of the transmutation of species, discussed in the last chapter, has gained some support from several naturalists, who want to avoid, as much as possible, the frequent need for a First Cause whenever geological evidence shows the gradual emergence of new species of animals and plants, along with the extinction of earlier ones. However, aside from a tendency to explain changes in the organic world through the consistent action of secondary causes, we've noted that many complex challenges arise for anyone trying to clarify the nature and reality of specific characteristics. If there is any reasonable doubt about the stability of species, the extent of transformation they can undergo might just come down to how much time we attribute to the history of living organisms.

Before entering upon the reasons which may be adduced for rejecting Lamarck's hypothesis, I shall recapitulate, in a few words, the phenomena, and the whole train of thought, by which I conceive it to have been suggested, and which have gained for this and analogous theories, both in ancient and modern times, a considerable number of votaries.

Before discussing the reasons for rejecting Lamarck's hypothesis, I’ll briefly summarize the phenomena and the line of thought that I believe led to it, which has attracted a significant following for this and similar theories, both in ancient and modern times.

In the first place, the various groups into which plants and animals may be thrown seem almost invariably, to a beginner, to be so natural, that he is usually convinced at first, as was Linnæus to the last, "that genera are as much founded in nature as the species which compose them."800 When by examining the numerous intermediate gradations the student finds all lines of demarcation to be in most instances obliterated, even where they at first appeared most distinct, he grows more and more sceptical as to the real existence of genera, and finally regards them as mere arbitrary and artificial signs, invented, like those 579 which serve to distinguish the heavenly constellations, for the convenience of classification, and having as little pretensions to reality.

In the beginning, the different categories of plants and animals often seem so naturally defined to a beginner that they are usually convinced, much like Linnæus was throughout his life, "that genera are just as rooted in nature as the species within them."800 However, as the student examines the many intermediate variations, they find that most boundaries are blurred, even where they initially seemed clearest. This leads them to become increasingly doubtful about the actual existence of genera, ultimately viewing them as simply arbitrary and artificial labels, created for the sake of classification, much like the symbols used to identify celestial constellations, with equally little claim to reality.

Doubts are then engendered in his mind as to whether species may not also be equally unreal. The student is probably first struck with the phenomenon, that some individuals are made to deviate widely from the ordinary type by the force of peculiar circumstances, and with the still more extraordinary fact, that the newly acquired peculiarities are faithfully transmitted to the offspring. How far, he asks, may such variations extend in the course of indefinite periods of time, and during great vicissitudes in the physical condition of the globe? His growing incertitude is at first checked by the reflection that nature has forbidden the intermixture of the descendants of distinct original stocks, or has, at least, entailed sterility on their offspring, thereby preventing their being confounded together, and pointing out that a multitude of distinct types must have been created in the beginning, and must have remained pure and uncorrupted to this day.

Doubts then arise in his mind about whether species might also be just as unreal. The student is likely first struck by the fact that some individuals can deviate significantly from the typical type due to unique circumstances, and by the even more remarkable reality that these new traits are reliably passed down to their offspring. He wonders how far such variations might go over indefinite periods of time and during major changes in the planet's physical conditions. His increasing uncertainty is initially tempered by the thought that nature has prevented the interbreeding of descendants from different original stocks, or at least has made their offspring infertile, thus stopping them from blending together and suggesting that many distinct types must have been created at the start and have remained pure and untainted to this day.

Relying on this general law, he endeavors to solve each difficult problem by direct experiment, until he is again astounded by the phenomenon of a prolific hybrid, and still more by an example of a hybrid perpetuating itself throughout several generations in the vegetable world. He then feels himself reduced to the dilemma of choosing between two alternatives; either to reject the test, or to declare that the two species, from the union of which the fruitful progeny has sprung, were mere varieties. If he prefer the latter, he is compelled to question the reality of the distinctness of all other supposed species which differ no more than the parents of such prolific hybrids; for although he may not be enabled immediately to procure, in all such instances, a fruitful offspring; yet experiments show, that after repeated failures, the union of two recognized species may at last, under very favorable circumstances, give birth to a fertile progeny. Such circumstances, therefore, the naturalist may conceive to have occurred again and again, in the course of a great lapse of ages.

Relying on this general principle, he tries to tackle each challenging problem through direct experimentation, until he is once again amazed by the phenomenon of a highly productive hybrid, and even more so by an example of a hybrid reproducing itself over several generations in the plant world. He then finds himself faced with a dilemma: either to dismiss the test or to claim that the two species that produced the fruitful offspring were simply varieties. If he chooses the latter, he has to question the reality of the distinctness of all other supposed species that differ no more than the parents of these productive hybrids; because, while he may not immediately be able to produce a fruitful offspring in every case, experiments show that after multiple failures, the combination of two established species can eventually, under very favorable conditions, lead to a fertile offspring. Therefore, the naturalist may think that such conditions have occurred repeatedly over a long stretch of time.

His first opinions are now fairly unsettled, and every stay at which he has caught has given way one after another; he is in danger of falling into any new and visionary doctrine which may be presented to him; for he now regards every part of the animate creation as void of stability, and in a state of continual flux. In this mood he encounters the Geologist, who relates to him how there have been endless vicissitudes in the shape and structure of organic beings in former ages—how the approach to the present system of things has been gradual—that there has been a progressive development of organization subservient to the purposes of life, from the most simple to the most complex state—that the appearance of man is the last phenomenon in a long succession of events—and, finally, that a series of physical revolutions can be traced in the inorganic world, coeval and co-extensive with those of organic nature.

His initial beliefs are now quite shaky, and every idea he’s held onto has fallen away one by one; he’s at risk of getting swept up in any new, fanciful theory that comes his way. He now sees every part of living nature as unstable and always changing. In this frame of mind, he meets the Geologist, who explains how there have been countless changes in the form and structure of living beings over the ages—how the current system has developed gradually—how life has progressed from the simplest to the most complex forms—how the emergence of humans is the final event in a long series of changes—and finally, how a series of physical changes can be traced in the non-living world, which are simultaneous and connected to those in the living world.

580 These views seem immediately to confirm all his preconceived doubts as to the stability of the specific character, and he begins to think there may exist an inseparable connection between a series of changes in the inanimate world, and the capability of the species to be indefinitely modified by the influence of external circumstances. Henceforth his speculations know no definite bounds; he gives the rein to conjecture, and fancies that the outward form, internal structure, instinctive faculties, nay, that reason itself may have been gradually developed from some of the simplest states of existence—that all animals, that man himself, and the irrational beings, may have had one common origin; that all may be parts of one continuous and progressive scheme of development, from the most imperfect to the more complex; in fine, he renounces his belief in the high genealogy of his species, and looks forward, as if in compensation, to the future perfectibility of man in his physical, intellectual, and moral attributes.

580 These views seem to immediately validate all his pre-existing doubts about the stability of specific traits, and he starts to consider that there might be an unbreakable link between a series of changes in the non-living world and the ability of species to be endlessly influenced and modified by external factors. From this point on, his thoughts have no clear limits; he allows his imagination to run wild and speculates that physical appearance, internal structure, instinctual behaviors, and even reason itself may have gradually evolved from some of the simplest forms of life—that all animals, including humans, and even non-sentient beings, might share a common origin; that they all might be parts of one continuous and evolving development process, moving from the most primitive to the more complex; ultimately, he abandons his belief in the noble lineage of his species and looks ahead, as if in compensation, to the future betterment of humanity in physical, intellectual, and moral qualities.

Let us now proceed to consider what is defective in evidence, and what fallacious in reasoning, in the grounds of these strange conclusions. Blumenbach judiciously observes, that "no general rule can be laid down for determining the distinctness of species, as there is no particular class of characters which can serve as a criterion. In each case we must be guided by analogy and probability." The multitude, in fact, and complexity of the proofs to be weighed is so great, that we can only hope to obtain presumptive evidence, and we must, therefore, be the more careful to derive our general views as much as possible from those observations where the chances of deception are least. We must be on our guard not to tread in the footsteps of the naturalists of the middle ages, who believed the doctrine of spontaneous generation to be applicable to all those parts of the animal and vegetable kingdoms which they least understood, in direct contradiction to the analogy of all the parts best known to them; and who, when at length they found that insects and cryptogamous plants were also propagated from eggs or seeds, still persisted in retaining their old prejudices respecting the infusory animalcules and other minute beings, the generation of which had not then been demonstrated by the microscope to be governed by the same laws.

Let’s now look at what's flawed in the evidence and what's misleading in the reasoning behind these strange conclusions. Blumenbach wisely points out that "no general rule can be established for determining the distinctness of species, as there is no specific set of traits that can serve as a standard. In each case, we must rely on analogy and probability." In reality, the sheer number and complexity of the evidence to consider is so vast that we can only hope to gather presumptive evidence. Therefore, we need to be extra cautious and base our general conclusions as much as possible on observations where the likelihood of error is minimal. We must be wary not to follow in the footsteps of naturalists from the Middle Ages, who believed in spontaneous generation for all parts of the animal and plant kingdoms that they least understood, contradicting the well-known characteristics of those they were more familiar with. When they eventually discovered that insects and certain plants reproduce from eggs or seeds, they still held onto their outdated beliefs about microscopic organisms and other tiny beings, whose generation had not yet been shown by the microscope to follow the same rules.

Lamarck has, indeed, attempted to raise an argument in favor of his system, out of the very confusion which has arisen in the study of some orders of animals and plants, in consequence of the slight shades of difference which separate the new species discovered within the last half century. That the embarrassment of those who attempt to classify and distinguish the new acquisitions, poured in such multitudes into our museums, should increase with the augmentation of their number, is quite natural; since to obviate this, it is not enough that our powers of discrimination should keep pace with the increase of the objects, but we ought to possess greater opportunities of studying each animal and plant in all stages of its growth, and to know profoundly their history, their habits, and physiological characters, throughout several generations; 581 for, in proportion as the series of known animals grows more complete none can doubt there is a nearer approximation to a graduated scale of being; and thus the most closely allied species will be found to possess a greater number of characters in common.

Lamarck has indeed tried to build an argument in support of his system from the confusion that has emerged in studying certain groups of animals and plants, due to the subtle differences separating the new species discovered in the last fifty years. It’s completely natural that the difficulties faced by those trying to classify and differentiate the new findings, which have flooded into our museums, would increase with their number. To overcome this challenge, it’s not enough for our ability to distinguish to keep up with the growing number of objects; we also need to have better opportunities to study each animal and plant at all stages of their growth, and to deeply understand their history, habits, and physiological traits across several generations; 581 because as the collection of known animals becomes more complete, it’s undeniable that we can approach a more graduated scale of life, where the most closely related species will show more common characteristics.

Causes of the difficulty of discriminating species.—But, in point of fact, our new acquisitions consist, more and more as we advance, of specimens brought from foreign and often very distant and barbarous countries. A large proportion have never even been seen alive by scientific inquirers. Instead of having specimens of the young, the adult, and the aged individuals of each sex, and possessing means of investigating the anatomical structure, the peculiar habits, and instincts of each, what is usually the state of our information? A single specimen, perhaps, of a dried plant, or a stuffed bird or quadruped; a shell, without the soft parts of the animal; an insect in one stage of its numerous transformations;—these are the scanty and imperfect data which the naturalist possesses. Such information may enable us to separate species which stand at a considerable distance from each other; but we have no right to expect any thing but difficulty and ambiguity, if we attempt, from such imperfect opportunities, to obtain distinctive marks for defining the characters of species which are closely related.

Causes of the difficulty of discriminating species.—In reality, as we move forward, our new collections consist more and more of specimens brought from foreign and often very distant and uncivilized countries. A large proportion have never even been seen alive by scientists. Instead of having examples of young, adult, and old individuals of each sex, along with ways to study their anatomical structure, unique behaviors, and instincts, what is usually the state of our knowledge? Typically, it's just a single specimen, perhaps a dried plant, or a stuffed bird or animal; a shell, lacking the soft parts of the creature; or an insect in just one stage of its many transformations—these are the limited and inadequate data available to the naturalist. Such information may help us distinguish species that are quite different from one another, but we can't expect anything but confusion and uncertainty if we try to find distinguishing features for defining closely related species from such incomplete information.

If Lamarck could introduce so much certainty and precision into the classification of several thousand species of recent and fossil shells, notwithstanding the extreme remoteness of the organization of these animals from the type of those vertebrated species which are best known, and in the absence of so many of the living inhabitants of shells, we are led to form an exalted conception of the degree of exactness to which specific distinctions are capable of being carried, rather than to call in question their reality.

If Lamarck could bring so much certainty and precision to classifying thousands of species of recent and fossil shells, despite how different these animals are from the well-known vertebrate species, and without many of the living shell inhabitants, we are inclined to have a high regard for the level of accuracy that specific distinctions can achieve, rather than doubting their existence.

When our data are so defective, the most acute naturalist must expect to be sometimes at fault, and, like the novice, to overlook essential points of difference, passing unconsciously from one species to another, until, like one who is borne along in a current, he is astonished on looking back, at observing that he has reached a point so remote from that whence he set out.

When our data is so faulty, even the sharpest naturalist must expect to occasionally make mistakes and, like a beginner, to miss key differences, unintentionally switching from one species to another, until, like someone being swept along by a current, they are shocked to realize that they have ended up so far from where they started.

It is by no means improbable, that, when the series of species of certain genera is very full, they may be found to differ less widely from each other than do the mere varieties or races of certain species. If such a fact could be established, it would, undoubtedly, diminish the chance of our obtaining certainty in our results; but it would by no means overthrow our confidence in the reality of species.

It’s definitely possible that when there are a lot of species within certain genera, they may end up being more similar to each other than the different varieties or races of certain species. If this is proven to be true, it would certainly reduce our chances of getting clear results, but it wouldn't shake our confidence in the existence of species at all.

Some mere varieties possibly more distinct than certain individuals of distinct species.—It is almost necessary, indeed, to suppose that varieties will differ in some cases more decidedly than some species, if we admit that there is a graduated scale of being, and assume that the following laws prevail in the economy of the animate creation:—first, that the organization of individuals is capable of being modified to a limited extent, by the force of external causes; secondly, that these 582 modifications are, to a certain extent, transmissible to their offspring; thirdly, that there are fixed limits, beyond which the descendants from common parents can never deviate from a certain type; fourthly, that each species springs from one original stock, and can never be permanently confounded by intermixing with the progeny of any other stock; fifthly, that each species shall endure for a considerable period of time. Now, let us assume, for the present, these rules hypothetically, and see what consequences may naturally be expected to result from them.

Some varieties might actually be more distinct than certain individuals of different species.—It's almost necessary to assume that some varieties will differ more clearly than some species if we accept that there is a hierarchy of living beings and that the following principles are at play in the natural world:—first, that the structure of individuals can be changed to some extent by external factors; secondly, that these 582 changes can be passed down to their offspring; thirdly, that there are established limits beyond which descendants from the same parents cannot stray from a specific type; fourthly, that each species originates from a single ancestral stock and cannot be permanently mixed with the offspring of any other stock; fifthly, that each species will last for a significant period of time. Now, let's assume these rules for now and see what natural outcomes we might expect from them.

We must suppose that when the Author of Nature creates an animal or plant, all the possible circumstances in which its descendants are destined to live are foreseen, and that an organization is conferred upon it which will enable the species to perpetuate itself and survive under all the varying circumstances to which it must be inevitably exposed. Now, the range of variation of circumstances will differ essentially in almost every case. Let us take, for example, any one of the most influential conditions of existence, such as temperature. In some extensive districts near the equator, the thermometer might never vary, throughout several thousand centuries, for more than 20° Fahrenheit; so that if a plant or animal be provided with an organization fitting it to endure such a range, it may continue on the globe for that immense period, although every individual might be liable at once to be cut off by the least possible excess of heat or cold beyond the determinate degree. But if a species be placed in one of the temperate zones, and have a constitution conferred on it capable of supporting a similar range of temperature only, it will inevitably perish before a single year has passed away.

We should assume that when the Creator of Nature designs an animal or plant, all the possible conditions its offspring will face are anticipated, and it is given a structure that allows the species to reproduce and thrive in all the different situations it will inevitably encounter. The variation in conditions will be quite different in nearly every case. For instance, consider one of the most significant environmental factors, like temperature. In certain extensive regions near the equator, the temperature might not change more than 20° Fahrenheit over thousands of years. So, if a plant or animal is built to withstand that temperature range, it can survive on Earth for that long, even though every individual could be wiped out by a slight increase or decrease in temperature beyond the set limit. However, if a species is situated in a temperate zone and has a makeup that only allows it to endure a similar range of temperatures, it will definitely die out within a single year.

Humboldt has shown that, at Cumana, within the tropics, there is a difference of only 4° Fahr. between the temperature of the warmest and coldest months; whereas, in the temperate zones, the annual variation amounts to about 60°, and the extreme range of the thermometer in Canada is not less than 90°.

Humboldt has demonstrated that, in Cumana, located within the tropics, there is only a 4° Fahrenheit difference between the temperatures of the warmest and coldest months. In contrast, in the temperate zones, the annual variation is around 60°, and the temperature range in Canada can be as much as 90°.

The same remark might be applied to any other condition, as food, for example; it may be foreseen that the supply will be regular throughout indefinite periods in one part of the world, and in another very precarious and fluctuating both in kind and quantity. Different qualifications may be required for enabling species to live for a considerable time under circumstances so changeable. If, then, temperature and food be among those external causes which, according to certain laws of animal and vegetable physiology, modify the organization, form, or faculties, of individuals, we instantly perceive that the degrees of variability from a common standard must differ widely in the two cases above supposed; since there is a necessity of accommodating a species in one case to a much greater latitude of circumstances than in the other.

The same observation could apply to any other condition, like food, for instance; it’s expected that the supply will remain steady for indefinite periods in one part of the world, while in another, it’s very uncertain and varies greatly in both type and amount. Different qualifications may be needed for species to survive for a significant time under such changing circumstances. If temperature and food are among those external factors that, according to certain laws of animal and plant physiology, affect the structure, form, or abilities of individuals, we can immediately see that the levels of variability from a common standard must differ significantly in the two scenarios mentioned; because one case requires a species to adapt to a much wider range of conditions than the other.

If it be a law, for instance, that scanty sustenance should check those individuals in their growth which are enabled to accommodate themselves to privations of this kind, and that a parent, prevented in this manner from attaining the size proper to its species, should produce a dwarfish offspring, a stunted race will arise, as is remarkably exemplified 583 in some varieties of the horse and dog. The difference of stature in some races of dogs, when compared to others, is as one to five in linear dimensions, making a difference of a hundred-fold in volume.801 Now, there is a good reason to believe that species in general are by no means susceptible of existing under a diversity of circumstances, which may give rise to such a disparity in size, and, consequently, there will be a multitude of distinct species, of which no two adult individuals can ever depart so widely from a certain standard of dimensions as the mere varieties of certain other species—the dog, for instance. Now, we have only to suppose that what is true of size, may also hold in regard to color and many other attributes; and it will at once follow, that the degree of possible discordance between varieties of the same species may, in certain cases, exceed the utmost disparity which can arise between two individuals of many distinct species.

If there’s a law that says limited food should stunt the growth of individuals who can adapt to such deprivation, and that a parent, being limited in this way, would produce a small offspring, then a stunted population will come about, as strongly shown in some breeds of horses and dogs. The height difference in some dog breeds compared to others is about one to five in length, resulting in a difference of a hundred times in volume.583 There’s good reason to believe that species, in general, are not really able to thrive under various conditions that could lead to such a difference in size, meaning there will be many distinct species, none of which can differ from a certain size standard as much as the simple varieties of certain other species—the dog, for example. If we assume that size differences might also apply to color and many other traits, it follows that the level of possible differences between varieties of the same species could, in some cases, be greater than the differences that can occur between two individuals of many different species.

The same remarks may hold true in regard to instincts; for, if it be foreseen that one species will have to encounter a great variety of foes, it may be necessary to arm it with great cunning and circumspection, or with courage or other qualities capable of developing themselves on certain occasions; such, for example, as those migratory instincts which are so remarkably exhibited at particular periods, after they have remained dormant for many generations. The history and habits of one variety of such a species may often differ more considerably from some other than those of many distinct species which have no such latitude of accommodation to circumstances.

The same points might apply to instincts; if it's anticipated that one species will face a wide range of enemies, it may need to be equipped with cleverness and caution, or with bravery or other traits that can develop in certain situations. For instance, take those migratory instincts that are strikingly displayed during specific times, even after being dormant for many generations. The history and behaviors of one type of such a species can often be much more different from another than the behaviors of many distinct species that lack this ability to adapt to their circumstances.

Extent of known variability in species.—Lamarck has somewhat mis-stated the idea commonly entertained of a species; for it is not true that naturalists in general assume that the organisation of an animal or plant remains absolutely constant, and that it can never vary in any of its parts.802 All must be aware that circumstances influence the habits, and that the habits may alter the state of the parts and organs; but the difference of opinion relates to the extent to which these modifications of the habits and organs of a particular species may be carried.

Extent of known variability in species.—Lamarck has somewhat misunderstood the common idea of a species; it's not true that naturalists generally believe that the structure of an animal or plant remains completely constant and can never change in any of its parts.802 Everyone knows that circumstances affect behaviors, and that these behaviors can change the condition of the parts and organs; however, the disagreement lies in how far these adaptations of habits and organs within a specific species can go.

Now, let us first inquire what positive facts can be adduced in the history of known species, to establish a great and permanent amount of change in the form, structure, or instinct of individuals descending from some common stock. The best authenticated examples of the extent to which species can be made to vary may be looked for in the history of domesticated animals and cultivated plants. It usually happens, that those species, both of the animal and vegetable kingdom, which have the greatest pliability of organisation, those which are most capable of accommodating themselves to a great variety of new circumstances, are most serviceable to man. These only can be carried by him into different climates, and can have their properties or instincts variously diversified by differences of nourishment 584 and habits. If the resources of a species be so limited, and its habits and faculties be of such a confined and local character, that it can only flourish in a few particular spots, it can rarely be of great utility.

Now, let’s first look at what positive evidence we can find in the history of known species to support the idea of significant and lasting changes in the form, structure, or instincts of individuals that come from a common ancestor. The best-documented examples of how much species can vary can be found in the history of domesticated animals and cultivated plants. Generally, the species, both in the animal and plant kingdoms, that have the greatest flexibility in their organization, and are most able to adapt to a wide range of new conditions, are the most useful to humans. Only these can be transported to different climates, and their traits or instincts can be modified in various ways depending on different diets and habits. If a species has such limited resources and its behaviors and abilities are so specific and localized that it can only thrive in a few select areas, it is unlikely to be very useful. 584

We may consider, therefore, that in the domestication of animals and the cultivation of plants, mankind have first selected those species which have the most flexible frames and constitutions, and have then been engaged for ages in conducting a series of experiments, with much patience and at great cost, to ascertain what may be the greatest possible deviation from a common type which can be elicited in these extreme cases.

We can think of it this way: in domesticating animals and growing plants, people first chose species with the most adaptable bodies and systems. For ages, they've conducted a series of experiments, with a lot of patience and at great expense, to find out the greatest possible variation from a common type that can be brought out in these extreme situations.

Varieties of the dog—no transmutation.—The modifications produced in the different races of dogs exhibit the influence of man in the most striking point of view. These animals have been transported into every climate and placed in every variety of circumstances; they have been made, as a modern naturalist observes, the servant, the companion, the guardian, and the intimate friend of man, and the power of a superior genius has had a wonderful influence not only on their forms, but on their manners and intelligence.803 Different races have undergone remarkable changes in the quantity and color of their clothing; the dogs of Guinea are almost naked, while those of the arctic circle are covered with a warm coat both of hair and wool, which enables them to bear the most intense cold without inconvenience. There are differences also of another kind no less remarkable, as in size, the length of their muzzles, and the convexity of their foreheads.

Dog breeds—no transformation.—The changes seen in different dog breeds highlight the impact of humans in a very obvious way. These animals have been brought to various climates and placed in all sorts of situations; they have become, as a modern naturalist notes, the servants, companions, protectors, and close friends of humans. The influence of a superior intellect has greatly affected not just their physical appearance, but also their behavior and intelligence.803 Different breeds have shown significant changes in the amount and color of their fur; the dogs from Guinea are almost hairless, while those from the Arctic are covered with a thick layer of both hair and wool, which allows them to withstand extreme cold without discomfort. There are also other noteworthy differences, such as size, the length of their snouts, and the shape of their foreheads.

But, if we look for some of those essential changes which would be required to lend even the semblance of a foundation for the theory of Lamarck, respecting the growth of new organs and the gradual obliteration of others, we find nothing of the kind. For, in all these varieties of the dog, says Cuvier, the relation of the bones with each other remains essentially the same; the form of the teeth never changes in any perceptible degree, except that, in some individuals, one additional false grinder occasionally appears, sometimes on the one side, and sometimes on the other.804 The greatest departure from a common type—and it constitutes the maximum of variation as yet known in the animal kingdom—is exemplified in those races of dogs which have a supernumerary toe on the hind foot with the corresponding tarsal bones; a variety analogous to one presented by six-fingered families of the human race.805

But if we look for some of those essential changes needed to provide any kind of foundation for Lamarck's theory about the growth of new organs and the gradual disappearance of others, we find nothing like that. According to Cuvier, in all these varieties of dogs, the relationship between the bones is essentially the same; the shape of the teeth hardly changes at all, except that in some individuals, an additional false grinder occasionally appears, sometimes on one side and sometimes on the other.804 The greatest deviation from a common type—and it represents the maximum variation known in the animal kingdom—is seen in those breeds of dogs that have an extra toe on the hind foot along with the corresponding tarsal bones; a variety similar to those families of humans with six fingers.805

Lamarck has thrown out as a conjecture, that the wolf may have been the original of the dog; and eminent naturalists are still divided in opinion on this subject. It seems now admitted that both species agree in the period of gestation, and Mr. Owen has been unable 585 to confirm the alleged difference in the structure of a part of the intestinal canal.806 Mr. Bell inclines to the opinion that all the various races of dogs have descended from one common stock, of which the wolf is the original source.

Lamarck suggested that the wolf might be the ancestor of the dog, and respected naturalists still have differing views on this topic. It now seems accepted that both species have the same gestation period, and Mr. Owen has not been able to confirm the supposed differences in part of the intestinal structure. Mr. Bell believes that all the different breeds of dogs come from a single common ancestor, which is the wolf.

It is well known that the horse, the ox, the boar, and other domestic animals which have been introduced into South America, and have run wild in many parts, have entirely lost all marks of domesticity, and have reverted to the original characters of their species. But dogs have also become wild in Cuba, Hayti, and in all the Caribbean islands. In the course of the seventeenth century, they hunted in packs from twelve to fifty, or more, in number, and fearlessly attacked herds of wild boars and other animals. It is natural, therefore, to inquire to what form they reverted? Now, they are said by many travellers to have resembled very nearly the shepherd's dog; but it is certain that they were never turned into wolves. They were extremely savage, and their ravages appear to have been as much dreaded as those of wolves; but when any of their whelps were caught, and brought from the woods to the towns, they grew up in the most perfect submission to man.807

It’s well known that horses, oxen, boars, and other domesticated animals introduced to South America have gone wild in many areas, completely losing their domesticated traits and reverting to the original characteristics of their species. Dogs have also become wild in Cuba, Haiti, and throughout the Caribbean islands. During the seventeenth century, they hunted in packs ranging from twelve to fifty or more and bravely attacked herds of wild boars and other animals. It’s natural, then, to ask which form they reverted to. Many travelers say they closely resembled a shepherd's dog, but it’s certain they never turned into wolves. They were extremely feral, and their attacks seemed to be feared as much as those of wolves. However, when any of their pups were captured and brought from the woods to towns, they grew up perfectly submissive to humans.807

Many examples might be adduced to prove that the extent to which the alteration of species can be pushed in the domestic state depends on the original capacity of the species to admit of variation. The horse has been as long domesticated as the dog, yet its different races depart much less widely from a common type; the ass has been still less changed, the camel scarcely at all; yet these species have probably been subjected to the influence of domestication as long as the horse.

Many examples could be given to show that how much a species can change in a domestic environment depends on its original ability to vary. The horse has been domesticated for as long as the dog, but its different breeds vary much less from a common type; the donkey has changed even less, and the camel hardly at all; yet these species have likely been affected by domestication for just as long as the horse.

Mummies of animals in Egyptian tombs identical with species still living.—As the advocates of the theory of transmutation trust much to the slow and insensible changes which time may work, they are accustomed to lament the absence of accurate descriptions, and figures of particular animals and plants, handed down from the earliest periods of history, such as might have afforded data for comparing the condition of species, at two periods considerably remote. But, fortunately, we are in some measure independent of such evidence: for, by a singular accident, the priests of Egypt have bequeathed to us, in their cemeteries, that information which the museums and works of the Greek philosophers have failed to transmit.

Mummies of animals in Egyptian tombs identical with species still living.—The supporters of the theory of evolution rely heavily on the slow and subtle changes that time can bring, and they often express frustration over the lack of detailed descriptions and images of specific animals and plants from the earliest times in history, which could have provided data for comparing the state of species at two vastly different periods. However, we are somewhat fortunate to be able to gather information independently of such evidence: because, through an unusual circumstance, the priests of Egypt have left us valuable insights in their cemeteries that the museums and writings of Greek philosophers have failed to preserve.

For the careful investigation of these documents, we are greatly indebted to the skill and diligence of those naturalists who accompanied the French armies during their brief occupation of Egypt: that conquest of four years, from which we may date the improvement of the modern Egyptians in the arts and sciences, and the rapid progress which has been made of late in our knowledge of the arts and sciences of their remote predecessors. Instead of wasting their whole time, as so many preceding travellers had done, in exclusively collecting human mummies, 586 M. Geoffrey and his associates examined diligently, and sent home great numbers of embalmed bodies of consecrated animals, such as the bull, the dog, the cat, the ape, the ichneumon, the crocodile, and the ibis.

For the careful investigation of these documents, we owe a lot to the skill and hard work of the naturalists who traveled with the French armies during their short occupation of Egypt. That four-year conquest marked the beginning of improvements for modern Egyptians in the arts and sciences, as well as the rapid progress we've made lately in understanding the arts and sciences of their ancient predecessors. Rather than spending all their time, like many earlier travelers, just collecting human mummies, 586 M. Geoffrey and his team thoroughly examined and sent back a large number of embalmed bodies of sacred animals, including the bull, dog, cat, ape, ichneumon, crocodile, and ibis.

To those who have never been accustomed to connect the facts of Natural History with philosophical speculations, who have never raised their conceptions of the end and import of such studies beyond the mere admiration of isolated and beautiful objects, or the exertion of skill in detecting specific differences, it will seem incredible that amidst the din of arms, and the stirring excitement of political movements, so much enthusiasm could have been felt in regard to these precious remains.

To people who have never thought about how Natural History relates to philosophical ideas, who have never considered the purpose and meaning of these studies beyond just admiring individual beautiful objects or the challenge of identifying specific differences, it might seem unbelievable that, amid the chaos of war and the excitement of political movements, so much passion could be felt for these valuable remains.

In the official report drawn up by the Professors of the Museum at Paris, on the value of these objects, there are some eloquent passages, which may appear extravagant, unless we reflect how fully these naturalists could appreciate the bearing of the facts thus brought to light on the past history of the globe.

In the official report created by the Professors of the Museum in Paris, assessing the value of these objects, there are some powerful passages that might seem exaggerated unless we consider how deeply these naturalists understood the significance of the facts revealed about the Earth's past history.

"It seems," say they, "as if the superstition of the ancient Egyptians had been inspired by Nature, with a view of transmitting to after ages a monument of her history. That extraordinary and eccentric people, by embalming with so much care the brutes which were the objects of their stupid adoration, have left us in their secret grottoes, cabinets of zoology almost complete. The climate has conspired with the art of embalming to preserve the bodies from corruption, and we can now assure ourselves by our own eyes what was the state of a great number of species three thousand years ago. We can scarcely restrain the transports of our imagination, on beholding thus preserved, with their minutest bones, with the smallest portions of their skin, and in every particular most perfectly recognizable, many an animal, which at Thebes or Memphis, two or three thousand years ago, had its own priests and altars."808

"It seems," they say, "like the superstitions of the ancient Egyptians were inspired by Nature, aiming to pass down a record of her history for future generations. That remarkable and unique society, by meticulously embalming the animals they stupidly worshipped, has left us with almost complete cabinets of zoology in their hidden grottoes. The climate, along with the art of embalming, has helped preserve the bodies from decay, allowing us to see with our own eyes the condition of many species three thousand years ago. We can hardly contain our excitement as we observe these preserved creatures, down to their tiniest bones and smallest bits of skin, which remain distinctly recognizable. Many of these animals had their own priests and altars in Thebes or Memphis two or three thousand years ago." 808

Among the Egyptian mummies thus procured were not only those of numerous wild quadrupeds, birds, and reptiles; but what was perhaps of still higher importance in deciding the great question under discussion, there were the mummies of domestic animals, among which those above mentioned, the bull, the dog, and the cat, were frequent. Now, such was the conformity of the whole of these species to those now living, that there was no more difference, says Cuvier, between them than between the human mummies and the embalmed bodies of men of the present day. Yet some of these animals have since that period been transported by man to almost every climate, and forced to accommodate their habits to the greatest variety of circumstances. The cat, for example, has been carried over the whole earth, and within the last three centuries, has been naturalized in every part of the new world,—from the cold regions of Canada to the tropical plains of Guiana; 587 yet it has scarcely undergone any perceptible mutation, and is still the same animal which was held sacred by the Egyptians.

Among the Egyptian mummies that were discovered were not only those of various wild mammals, birds, and reptiles, but also, and perhaps more importantly for the ongoing discussion, the mummies of domestic animals. Among these, the bull, the dog, and the cat were common. The similarity of all these species to those we have today is such that, according to Cuvier, there's no significant difference between them and the human mummies compared to modern-day bodies. However, some of these animals have since been moved by humans to nearly every climate, adapting their habits to a wide range of conditions. The cat, for instance, has spread across the globe and, in the last three centuries, has become established in every part of the New World—from the chilly regions of Canada to the tropical areas of Guiana; 587 yet it has hardly changed at all and remains the same animal that the Egyptians revered.

Of the ox, undoubtedly, there are many very distinct races; but the bull Apis, which was led in solemn processions by the Egyptian priests, did not differ from some of those now living. The black cattle that have run wild in America, where there were many peculiarities in the climate not to be found, perhaps, in any part of the old world, and where scarcely a single plant on which they fed was of precisely the same species, instead of altering their form and habits, have actually reverted to the exact likeness of the aboriginal wild cattle of Europe.

Of the ox, there are certainly many distinct breeds; however, the bull Apis, which was led in formal processions by Egyptian priests, is not much different from some of those alive today. The black cattle that have gone wild in America, where there are many unique climate features not found in the Old World, and where almost no single plant they fed on was exactly the same species, have actually returned to the exact appearance of the original wild cattle of Europe instead of changing their form and behavior.

In answer to the arguments drawn from the Egyptian mummies, Lamarck said they were identical with their living descendants in the same country, because the climate and physical geography of the banks of the Nile have remained unaltered for the last thirty centuries. But why, it may be asked, have other individuals of these species retained the same characters in many different quarters of the globe, where the climate and many other conditions are so varied?

In response to the arguments about Egyptian mummies, Lamarck stated that they are the same as their living descendants in the same country since the climate and physical geography of the Nile banks have remained unchanged for the past thirty centuries. But one might wonder, why have other individuals of these species maintained the same traits in so many different parts of the world, where the climate and a number of other conditions vary greatly?

Seeds and plants from the Egyptian tombs.—The evidence derived from the Egyptian monuments was not confined to the animal kingdom; the fruits, seeds, and other portions of twenty different plants, were faithfully preserved in the same manner; and among these the common wheat was procured by Delille, from closed vessels in the sepulchres of the kings, the grain of which retained not only their form but even their color; so effectual has proved the process of embalming with bitumen in a dry and equable climate. No difference could be detected between this wheat and that which now grows in the East and elsewhere; and in regard to the barley, I am informed by Mr. Brown, the celebrated botanist, that its identity with the grain of our own times can be tested by the closest comparison. On examining, for example, one of the seeds from Mr. Sam's Egyptian collection in the British Museum, it is found that "the structure of the husks or that part of the flower which is persistent, agrees precisely with the barley of the present day, in having one perfect flower and the filiform rudiments of a second." Some naturalists believe that the perfect identification of the ancient Egyptian cerealia with the varieties now cultivated has been carried still further, by sowing the seeds taken out of the catacombs, and raising plants from them; but we want more evidence of this fact. Certain it is, that when the experiment was recently made in the botanic garden at Kew, with 100 seeds of wheat, barley, and lentils, from the Egyptian collection before mentioned of the British Museum, not one of them would germinate.809

Seeds and plants from the Egyptian tombs.—The evidence found in Egyptian monuments extended beyond just animals; the fruits, seeds, and other parts of twenty different plants were carefully preserved in the same way. Among these, common wheat was obtained by Delille from sealed containers in the tombs of the kings, and the grains still retained their shape and even their color. This shows how effective the embalming process with bitumen was in a dry and stable climate. There was no noticeable difference between this wheat and what is currently grown in the East and elsewhere. Regarding barley, Mr. Brown, the famous botanist, tells me that it can be closely matched to modern grain. For instance, when examining a seed from Mr. Sam's Egyptian collection at the British Museum, it was found that "the structure of the husks, or the part of the flower that remains, precisely matches today's barley, having one complete flower and the thin remains of a second." Some naturalists think that we’ve gone even further in confirming the exact match of ancient Egyptian cereals with today's cultivated varieties by sowing seeds taken from the catacombs and growing plants from them; however, we need more proof of this. What is certain is that when a recent experiment was carried out in the botanic garden at Kew using 100 seeds of wheat, barley, and lentils from that same Egyptian collection in the British Museum, none of them germinated.809

588 Native country of the common wheat.—And here I may observe that there is an obvious answer to Lamarck's objection, that the botanist cannot point out a country where the common wheat grows wild, unless in places where it may have been derived from neighboring cultivation.810 All naturalists are well aware that the geographical distribution of a great number of species is extremely limited; that it was to be expected that every useful plant should first be cultivated successfully in the country where it was indigenous; and that, probably, every station which it partially occupied, when growing wild, would be selected by the agriculturist as best suited to it when artificially increased. Palestine has been conjectured, by a late writer on the cerealia, to have been the original habitation of wheat and barley; a supposition which is rendered the more plausible by Hebrew and Egyptian traditions, and by tracing the migrations of the worship of Ceres, as indicative of the migrations of the plant.811

588 Native country of the common wheat.—Here, I’d like to point out that there’s a clear response to Lamarck’s criticism that botanists can’t identify a place where common wheat grows wild, except in areas where it may have come from nearby farming.810 All naturalists know that many species have a very limited geographical range; it’s expected that every useful plant would first be successfully grown in its native country and that any area it naturally grew in would likely be chosen by farmers as the best fit for it when cultivated. A recent writer on cereals speculated that Palestine was the original home of wheat and barley, a guess supported by Hebrew and Egyptian traditions and by tracking the spread of Ceres’s worship as a sign of the plant’s movement.811

If we are to infer that some one of the wild grasses has been transformed into the common wheat, and that some animal of the genus Canis, still unreclaimed, has been metamorphosed into the dog, merely because we cannot find the domestic dog, or the cultivated wheat, in a state of nature, we may be next called upon to make similar admissions in regard to the camel; for it seems very doubtful whether any race of this species of quadruped is now wild.

If we assume that a certain type of wild grass has changed into common wheat, and that some animal from the genus Canis, which is still wild, has evolved into the dog just because we can’t find domestic dogs or cultivated wheat in the wild, we might also have to accept similar claims about the camel; since it’s quite uncertain if any wild version of this species of quadruped still exists.

Changes in plants produced by cultivation.—But if agriculture, it will be said, does not supply examples of extraordinary changes of form and organization, the horticulturist can, at least, appeal to facts which may confound the preceding train of reasoning. The crab has been transformed into the apple; the sloe into the plum; flowers have changed their color, and become double; and these new characters can be perpetuated by seed; a bitter plant, with wavy sea-green leaves, has been taken from the sea-side, where it grew like wild charlock; has been transplanted into the garden, lost its saltness, and has been metamorphosed into two distinct vegetables, as unlike each other as is each to the parent plant—the red cabbage and the cauliflower. These, and a multitude of analogous facts, are undoubtedly among the wonders of nature, and attest more strongly, perhaps, the extent to which species may be modified, than any examples derived from the animal kingdom. But in these cases we find that we soon reach certain limits, beyond which we are unable to cause the individuals descending from the same stock to vary; while, on the other hand, it is easy to show that these extraordinary varieties could seldom arise, and could never be perpetuated in a wild state for many generations, under any imaginable combination of accidents. They may be regarded as extreme 589 cases, brought about by human interference, and not as phenomena which indicate a capability of indefinite modification in the natural world.

Changes in plants produced by cultivation.—But if agriculture doesn’t show examples of extraordinary changes in form and organization, the horticulturist can at least refer to facts that might challenge that thinking. The crab apple has been turned into a regular apple; the sloe has transformed into a plum; flowers have changed color and become double; and these new traits can be passed down through seeds. A bitter plant, with wavy sea-green leaves, was taken from the seaside, where it grew like wild charlock; it was moved to a garden, lost its saltiness, and changed into two completely different vegetables, as different from each other as they are from the parent plant—the red cabbage and the cauliflower. These, along with many similar examples, are surely wonders of nature, showing perhaps even more strongly how much species can be modified than any examples from the animal kingdom. However, in these cases, we find that we quickly reach certain limits beyond which we can’t make the descendants from the same stock vary; on the other hand, it’s easy to show that these extraordinary varieties would rarely appear and could never last in a wild state for many generations, no matter the combination of circumstances. They can be seen as extreme 589 cases created by human interference, rather than as phenomena suggesting a potential for unlimited modification in the natural world.

The propagation of a plant by buds or grafts, and by cuttings, is obviously a mode which nature does not employ; and this multiplication, as well as that produced by roots and layers, seems merely to operate as an extension of the life of an individual, and not as a reproduction of the species such as happens by seed. All plants increased by grafts or layers retain precisely the peculiar qualities of the individual to which they owe their origin, and, like an individual, they have only a determinate existence; in some cases longer, and in others shorter.812 It seems now admitted by horticulturists, that none of our garden varieties of fruit are entitled to be considered strictly permanent, but that they wear out after a time;813 and we are thus compelled to resort again to seeds; in which case there is so decided a tendency in the seedlings to revert to the original type, that our utmost skill is sometimes baffled in attempting to recover the desired variety.

The way a plant is propagated through buds, grafts, and cuttings is clearly not a method that nature uses. This kind of multiplication, along with that from roots and layers, seems to just extend the life of a single plant rather than reproduce the species like seed production does. All plants that grow from grafts or layers retain the exact traits of the original plant they came from, and like an individual plant, they have a limited lifespan—sometimes longer, sometimes shorter.812 Horticulturists now generally agree that none of our cultivated fruit varieties can be considered permanently stable; they eventually wear out over time;813 and we are therefore forced to go back to using seeds. In this case, there’s a strong tendency for seedlings to revert to the original type, making it challenging, despite our best efforts, to recreate the desired variety.

Varieties of the cabbage.—The different races of cabbages afford, as was admitted, an astonishing example of deviation from a common type; but we can scarcely conceive them to have originated, much less to have lasted for several generations, without the intervention of man. It is only by strong manures that these varieties have been obtained, and in poorer soils they instantly degenerate. If, therefore, we suppose in a state of nature the seed of the wild Brassica oleracea to have been wafted from the sea-side to some spot enriched by the dung of animals, and to have there become a cauliflower, it would soon diffuse its seed to some comparatively sterile soils around, and the offspring would relapse to the likeness of the parent stock.

Varieties of the cabbage.—The different types of cabbages show a remarkable variation from a common ancestor; however, it's hard to believe they could have developed, much less sustained themselves for several generations, without human involvement. These varieties have been cultivated through the use of strong fertilizers, and in poorer soils, they quickly revert to their original form. So, if we imagine the seed of the wild Brassica oleracea being carried from the seaside to a location enriched by animal waste, and then transforming into a cauliflower, it wouldn't take long for its seeds to spread to the nearby less fertile areas, and its descendants would revert to looking like the original plant.

But if we go so far as to imagine the soil, in the spot first occupied, to be constantly manured by herds of wild animals, so as to continue as rich as that of a garden, still the variety could not be maintained; because we know that each of these races is prone to fecundate others, and gardeners are compelled to exert the utmost diligence to prevent cross-breeds. The intermixture of the pollen of varieties growing in the poorer soil around would soon destroy the peculiar characters of the race which occupied the highly manured tract; for, if these accidents so continually happen, in spite of our care, among the culinary varieties, it is easy to see how soon this cause might obliterate every marked singularity in a wild state.

But if we imagine that the soil in the area first occupied is continually enriched by herds of wild animals to keep it as fertile as a garden, the variety still couldn't be sustained. This is because we know that each of these species tends to fertilize others, and gardeners have to work really hard to prevent crossbreeding. The mixing of pollen from varieties growing in the poorer soil nearby would quickly erase the unique traits of the species thriving on the well-fertilized land. If these accidents happen so frequently, despite our efforts, among cultivated varieties, it's easy to see how fast this could eliminate any distinct characteristics in a wild setting.

Besides, it is well known that, although the pampered races which we rear in our gardens for use or ornament may often be perpetuated by seed, yet they rarely produce seed in such abundance, or so prolific in quality, as wild individuals; so that if the care of man were withdrawn, the most fertile variety would always, in the end, prevail over the more sterile.

Besides, it’s well known that although the pampered breeds we cultivate in our gardens for use or decoration can sometimes reproduce by seed, they rarely produce seed in such abundance or quality as their wild counterparts. So, if humans stopped taking care of them, the most fertile varieties would ultimately prevail over the less productive ones.

590Similar remarks may be applied to the double flowers, which present such strange anomalies to the botanist. The ovarium, in such cases, is frequently abortive; and the seeds, when prolific, are generally much fewer than where the flowers are single.

590Similar comments can be made about double flowers, which show some odd traits to the botanist. In these cases, the ovary is often ineffective, and when the seeds are numerous, they are usually much fewer than in single flowers.

Changes caused by soil.—Some curious experiments, recently made on the production of blue instead of red flowers in the Hydrangea hortensis, illustrate the immediate effect of certain soils on the colors of the calyx and petals. In garden-mould or compost, the flowers are invariably red; in some kinds of bog-earth they are blue; and the same change is always produced by a particular sort of yellow loam.

Changes caused by soil.—Some interesting experiments recently conducted on the production of blue instead of red flowers in the Hydrangea hortensis show the direct impact of specific soils on the colors of the calyx and petals. In garden soil or compost, the flowers are always red; in certain types of bog soil, they are blue; and the same change consistently occurs with a particular type of yellow loam.

Varieties of the primrose.—Linnæus was of opinion that the primrose, oxlip, cowslip, and polyanthus, were only varieties of the same species. The majority of the modern botanists, on the contrary, consider them to be distinct, although some conceived that the oxlip might be a cross between the cowslip and the primrose. Mr. Herbert has lately recorded the following experiment:—"I raised from the natural seed of one umbel of a highly manured red cowslip a primrose, a cowslip, oxlips of the usual and other colors, a black polyanthus, a hose-in-hose cowslip, and a natural primrose bearing its flower on a polyanthus stalk. From the seed of that very hose-in-hose cowslip I have since raised a hose-in-hose primrose. I therefore consider all these to be only local varieties, depending upon soil and situation."814 Professor Henslow, of Cambridge, has since confirmed this experiment of Mr. Herbert; so that we have an example, not only of the remarkable varieties which the florist can obtain from a common stock, but of the distinctness of analogous races found in a wild state.815

Varieties of the primrose.—Linnaeus believed that the primrose, oxlip, cowslip, and polyanthus were just different varieties of the same species. However, most modern botanists see them as separate species, although some think that the oxlip might be a hybrid between the cowslip and the primrose. Recently, Mr. Herbert reported the following experiment:—“I grew several plants from the natural seed of one umbel of a heavily fertilized red cowslip, including a primrose, a cowslip, some oxlips in various colors, a black polyanthus, a double (hose-in-hose) cowslip, and a natural primrose with its flower on a polyanthus stalk. From the seeds of that very double cowslip, I have since grown a double primrose. I therefore believe that all these are just local varieties, influenced by the soil and location.”814 Professor Henslow from Cambridge has since confirmed Mr. Herbert's experiment, providing an example not only of the amazing varieties a florist can create from a common stock, but also of the distinctness of similar species found in the wild.815

On what particular ingredient, or quality in the earth, these changes depend, has not yet been ascertained.816 But gardeners are well aware that particular plants, when placed under the influence of certain circumstances, are changed in various ways, according to the species; and as often as the experiments are repeated, similar results are obtained. The nature of these results, however, depends upon the species, and they are, therefore, part of the specific character; they exhibit the same phenomena, again and again, and indicate certain fixed and invariable relations between the physiological peculiarities of the plant, and the influence of certain external agents. They afford no ground for questioning the instability of species, but rather the contrary; they present us with a class of phenomena, which, when they are more thoroughly understood, may afford some of the best tests for identifying species, and proving that the attributes originally conferred endure so long as any issue of the original stock remains upon the earth.

The specific ingredient or quality in the soil that leads to these changes is still unknown.816 However, gardeners know that certain plants can change in various ways when exposed to specific circumstances, depending on the species; and every time these experiments are repeated, similar outcomes occur. The nature of these outcomes, however, varies by species, making them part of their unique characteristics; they show the same patterns repeatedly and reveal fixed and unchanging relationships between the plant's physiological traits and the influence of external factors. This provides no reason to doubt the stability of species; rather, it highlights a set of phenomena that, once better understood, could serve as one of the best ways to identify species and demonstrate that the qualities originally present persist as long as any descendants of the original stock exist on Earth.


CHAPTER XXXV.

WHETHER SPECIES HAVE A REAL EXISTENCE IN NATURE—continued.

Limits of the variability of species—Species susceptible of modification may be altered greatly in a short time, and in a few generations; after which they remain stationary—The animals now subject to man had originally an aptitude to domesticity—Acquired peculiarities which become hereditary have a close connexion with the habits or instincts of the species in a wild state—Some qualities in certain animals have been conferred with a view of their relation to man—Wild elephant domesticated in a few years, but its faculties incapable of further development.]

Limits of the variability of species—Species that can change can be significantly altered in a short amount of time, and within just a few generations; after that, they tend to stay the same—The animals now under human care originally had a natural potential for domestication—Inherited traits that develop over time are closely linked to the behaviors or instincts of the species when they are in the wild—Certain traits in some animals have been developed to enhance their relationship with humans—Wild elephants can be domesticated in a few years, but their abilities can't be further improved.

Variability of a species compared to that of an individual.—I endeavored, in the last chapter, to show, that a belief in the reality of species is not inconsistent with the idea of a considerable degree of variability in the specific character. This opinion, indeed, is little more than an extension of the idea which we must entertain of the identity of an individual, throughout the changes which it is capable of undergoing.

Variability of a species compared to that of an individual.—In the last chapter, I tried to demonstrate that believing in the existence of species does not contradict the notion that there is a significant amount of variability in specific characteristics. This viewpoint is, in fact, just an extension of how we understand the identity of an individual, even as it undergoes various changes.

If a quadruped, inhabiting a cold northern latitude, and covered with a warm coat of hair or wool, be transported to a southern climate, it will often, in the course of a few years, shed a considerable portion of its coat, which it gradually recovers on being again restored to its native country. Even there the same changes are, perhaps, superinduced to a certain extent by the return of winter and summer. We know that the Alpine hare (Lepus variabilis, Pal.) and the ermine, or stoat, (Mustela erminea, Linn.) become white during winter, and again obtain their full color during the warmer season; that the plumage of the ptarmigan undergoes a like metamorphosis in color and quantity, and that the change is equally temporary. We are aware that, if we reclaim some wild animal, and modify its habits and instincts by domestication, it may, if it escapes, become in a few years nearly as wild and untractable as ever; and if the same individual be again retaken, it may be reduced to its former tame state. A plant is sown in a prepared soil, in order that the petals of its flowers may multiply, and their color be heightened or changed: if we then withhold our care, the flowers of this same species become again single. In these, and innumerable other instances, we must suppose that the species was produced with a certain number of qualities; and, in the case of animals, with a variety of instincts, some of which may or may not be developed according to circumstances, or which, after having been called forth, may again become latent when the exciting causes are removed.

If a four-legged animal that lives in a cold northern climate and has a thick coat of hair or wool is moved to a southern climate, it will often shed a significant amount of its coat over a few years and will gradually grow it back if returned to its original environment. Even there, similar changes may occur to some extent with the changing of winter and summer. We know that the Alpine hare (Lepus variabilis, Pal.) and the ermine, or stoat, (Mustela erminea, Linn.) turn white in winter and regain their original color during the warmer months; the plumage of the ptarmigan changes color and texture in a similar way, and this change is also temporary. We understand that if we tame a wild animal and change its habits and instincts through domestication, it can become almost as wild and difficult to handle again if it escapes. However, if that same animal is caught again, it can revert to its former tame state. A plant is planted in prepared soil so that its flowers can multiply and their colors can become brighter or change; if we then stop taking care of it, the flowers of that same species will become simple again. In these and countless other cases, we must assume that the species was created with a specific set of traits; for animals, this includes various instincts, some of which may or may not develop depending on the circumstances, or which, after being activated, may become dormant again when the stimulus is removed.

592 Now, the formation of races seems the necessary consequence of such a capability in species to vary, if it be a general law that the offspring should very closely resemble the parent. But, before we can infer that there are no limits to the deviation from an original type which may be brought about in the course of an indefinite number of generations, we ought to have some proof that, in each successive generation, individuals may go on acquiring an equal amount of new peculiarities, under the influence of equal changes of circumstances. The balance of evidence, however, inclines most decidedly on the opposite side; for in all cases we find that the quantity of divergence diminishes after a few generations in a very rapid ratio.

592 Now, the formation of races seems to be a necessary outcome of species' ability to change, especially if it’s a general rule that offspring closely resemble their parents. But before we can conclude that there's no limit to how much a species can deviate from its original type over countless generations, we need proof that in each successive generation, individuals can keep acquiring an equal amount of new traits due to similar changes in their environment. However, the evidence strongly suggests otherwise; in all cases, we find that the degree of divergence decreases rapidly after just a few generations.

Species susceptible of modification may be greatly altered in a few generations.—It cannot be objected, that it is out of our power to go on varying the circumstances in the same manner as might happen in the natural course of events during some great geological cycle. For in the first place, where a capacity is given to individuals to adapt themselves to new circumstances, it does not generally require a very long period for its development: if, indeed, such were the case, it is not easy to see how the modification would answer the ends proposed, for all the individuals would die before new qualities, habits, or instincts were conferred.

Species that can be changed can undergo significant transformations in just a few generations.—It's not valid to argue that we can't keep altering the circumstances in the same way that might occur during a major geological period. First of all, when individuals have the ability to adapt to new situations, it usually doesn't take a long time for this ability to develop. If it did take a long time, it’s hard to see how such modifications would achieve their intended purposes, since all individuals would die before they could acquire new traits, behaviors, or instincts.

When we have succeeded in naturalizing some tropical plant in a temperate climate, nothing prevents us from attempting gradually to extend its distribution to higher latitudes, or to greater elevations above the level of the sea, allowing equal quantities of time, or an equal number of generations, for habituating the species to successive increments of cold. But every husbandman and gardener is aware that such experiments will fail; and we are more likely to succeed in making some plants, in the course of the first two generations, support a considerable degree of difference of temperature, than a very small difference afterwards, though we persevere for many centuries.

When we successfully adapt a tropical plant to a temperate climate, nothing stops us from trying to gradually expand its range to higher latitudes or greater elevations above sea level, giving equal amounts of time or generations for the species to adjust to increasing cold. However, every farmer and gardener knows that these experiments often fail; it’s usually easier to get some plants to tolerate a significant temperature difference within the first two generations than to adapt them to a minor difference later on, even if we keep at it for many centuries.

It is the same if we take any other cause instead of temperature; such as the quality of the food, or the kind of dangers to which an animal is exposed, or the soil in which a plant lives. The alteration in habits, form, or organization, is often rapid during a short period; but when the circumstances are made to vary farther, though in ever so slight a degree, all modification ceases, and the individual perishes. Thus some herbivorous quadrupeds may be made to feed partially on fish or flesh; but even these can never be taught to live on some herbs which they reject, and which would even poison them, although the same may be very nutritious to other species of the same natural order. So when man uses force or stratagem against wild animals, the persecuted race soon becomes more cautious, watchful, and cunning; new instincts seem often to be developed, and to become hereditary in the first two or three generations: but let the skill and address of man increase, however gradually, no farther variation can take place, no new 593 qualities are elicited by the increasing dangers. The alteration of the habits of the species has reached a point beyond which no ulterior modification is possible, however indefinite the lapse of ages during which the new circumstances operate. Extirpation then follows, rather than such a transformation as could alone enable the species to perpetuate itself under the new state of things.

It’s the same if we consider any other factor instead of temperature, like the quality of food, the types of dangers an animal faces, or the soil where a plant grows. Changes in habits, shape, or structure can happen quickly over a short time; however, if the conditions change even slightly beyond a certain point, all modifications stop, and the individual dies. For instance, some herbivorous mammals can be made to eat some fish or meat, but they can never be taught to consume certain plants that they reject, which could even be poisonous to them, even though those plants might be very nutritious for other species in the same family. Similarly, when humans use force or trickery against wild animals, the affected species quickly becomes more cautious, alert, and clever; new instincts often seem to emerge and can become inherited in the first two or three generations. But as human skill and strategy improve, no further changes occur, and no new traits emerge from increasing threats. The changes in species’ habits reach a limit beyond which no further changes can happen, no matter how long the new conditions last. Extinction then occurs instead of the type of transformation that would allow the species to survive in the new circumstances.

Animals now subject to man had originally an aptitude to domesticity.—It has been well observed by M. F. Cuvier and M. Dureau de la Malle, that unless some animals had manifested in a wild state an aptitude to second the efforts of man, their domestication would never have been attempted. If they had all resembled the wolf, the fox, and the hyæna, the patience of the experimentalist would have been exhausted by innumerable failures before he at last succeeded in obtaining some imperfect results; so if the first advantages derived from the cultivation of plants had been elicited by as tedious and costly a process as that by which we now make some slight additional improvements in certain races, we should have remained to this day in ignorance of the greater number of their useful qualities.

Animals that are now domesticated originally had a natural ability to live alongside humans.—It has been wisely noted by M. F. Cuvier and M. Dureau de la Malle that if some animals hadn’t shown an ability to assist humans in the wild, we would never have tried to domesticate them. If all animals were like wolves, foxes, and hyenas, the patience of those experimenting would have run out after countless failures before achieving even minor successes. Similarly, if the early benefits we gained from cultivating plants had taken as long and expensive a process as the slight improvements we make now on certain varieties, we would still be unaware of most of their useful qualities today.

Acquired instincts of some animals become hereditary.—It is undoubtedly true, that many new habits and qualities have not only been acquired in recent times by certain races of dogs, but have been transmitted to their offspring. But in these cases it will be observed, that the new peculiarities have an intimate relation to the habits of the animal in a wild state, and therefore do not attest any tendency to a departure to an indefinite extent from the original type of the species. A race of dogs employed for hunting deer in the platform of Sante Fé, in Mexico, affords a beautiful illustration of a new hereditary instinct. The mode of attack, observes M. Roulin, which they employ consists in seizing the animal by the belly and overturning it by a sudden effort, taking advantage of the moment when the body of the deer rests only upon the fore-legs. The weight of the animal thus thrown over is often six times that of its antagonist. The dog of pure breed inherits a disposition to this kind of chase, and never attacks a deer from before while running. Even should the deer, not perceiving him, come directly upon him, the dog steps aside and makes his assault on the flank; whereas other hunting dogs, though of superior strength, and general sagacity, which are brought from Europe, are destitute of this instinct. For want of similar precautions, they are often killed by the deer on the spot, the vertebræ of their neck being dislocated by the violence of the shock.817

Instincts that some animals acquire can become hereditary.—It’s definitely true that many new habits and traits have not only been developed recently by certain breeds of dogs but have also been passed down to their puppies. However, in these cases, it’s important to note that the new traits are closely related to the behaviors of the animal in the wild and therefore don’t indicate a significant departure from the original type of the species. A breed of dogs used for hunting deer in the plateau of Santa Fe, Mexico, serves as a great example of a new hereditary instinct. According to M. Roulin, their method of attack involves grabbing the deer by the belly and flipping it over with a quick move, taking advantage of the moment when the deer is resting on its forelegs. The weight of the animal being thrown can often be six times that of the dog. Purebred dogs inherit the inclination for this type of hunt and never attack a deer from the front while it’s running. Even if the deer, not seeing him, comes right at him, the dog will move aside and attack from the side; meanwhile, other hunting dogs, although stronger and generally smarter, which are brought in from Europe, lack this instinct. Due to the absence of such tactics, they are often killed by the deer on the spot, with their neck vertebrae dislocated by the force of the impact.817

A new instinct has also become hereditary in a mongrel race of dogs employed by the inhabitants of the banks of the Magdalena almost exclusively in hunting the white-lipped pecari. The address of these dogs consists in restraining their ardor, and attaching themselves to no animal in particular, but keeping the whole herd in check. Now, 594 among these dogs some are found, which the very first time they are taken to the woods, are acquainted with this mode of attack; whereas, a dog of another breed starts forward at once, is surrounded by the pecari, and, whatever may be his strength, is destroyed in a moment.

A new instinct has also become common in a mixed breed of dogs used by people living along the Magdalena River, primarily for hunting the white-lipped peccary. The skill of these dogs lies in controlling their excitement and not focusing on just one animal, but instead keeping the entire herd in line. Now, 594 some of these dogs, even during their first trip to the woods, instinctively understand this method of hunting; in contrast, a dog from another breed rushes in right away, gets surrounded by the peccaries, and no matter how strong it is, is quickly defeated.

Some of our countrymen, engaged of late in conducting one of the principal mining associations in Mexico, that of Real del Monte, carried out with them some English greyhounds of the best breed, to hunt the hares which abound in that country. The great platform which is the scene of sport is at an elevation of about nine thousand feet above the level of the sea, and the mercury in the barometer stands habitually at the height of about nineteen inches. It was found that the greyhounds could not support the fatigues of a long chase in this attenuated atmosphere, and before they could come up with their prey, they lay down gasping for breath; but these same animals have produced whelps which have grown up, and are not in the least degree incommoded by the want of density in the air, but run down the hares with as much ease as the fleetest of their race in this country.

Some of our fellow countrymen, recently involved in running one of the major mining associations in Mexico, specifically Real del Monte, brought along some top-quality English greyhounds to hunt the abundant hares in that region. The main platform for hunting is located at about nine thousand feet above sea level, where the barometer typically reads around nineteen inches. It turned out that the greyhounds couldn't handle the strain of a long chase in this thin atmosphere, and before they could catch their prey, they collapsed, struggling to breathe. However, these same dogs produced puppies that grew up without any issues related to the low air density. They chase down hares with the same ease as the fastest greyhounds in this country.

The fixed and deliberate stand of the pointer has with propriety been regarded as a mere modification of a habit, which may have been useful to a wild race accustomed to wind game, and steal upon it by surprise, first pausing for an instant, in order to spring with unerring aim. The faculty of the retriever, however, may justly be regarded as more inexplicable and less easily referable to the instinctive passions of the species. M. Majendie, says a French writer in a recently published memoir, having learnt that there was a race of dogs in England which stopped and brought back game of their own accord, procured a pair, and having obtained a whelp from them, kept it constantly under his eyes, until he had an opportunity of assuring himself that, without having received any instruction, and on the very first day that it was carried to the chase, it brought back game with as much steadiness as dogs which had been schooled into the same manœuvre by means of the whip and collar.

The fixed and intentional stance of the pointer is often seen as just a variation of a habit that may have been useful for wild dogs used to hunting game and sneaking up on it by surprise, first pausing for a moment before leaping with perfect accuracy. However, the abilities of the retriever are considered more mysterious and harder to connect to the basic instincts of the species. M. Majendie, as mentioned by a French writer in a recently published paper, learned about a breed of dogs in England that would stop and retrieve game on their own. He got a pair of these dogs, and after having a puppy from them, kept it constantly in his sight until he could confirm that, without any training, on its very first day out hunting, it brought back game with as much consistency as dogs that had been trained using a whip and collar.

Attributes of animals in their relation to man.—Such attainments, as well as the habits and dispositions which the shepherd's dog and many others inherit, seem to be of a nature and extent which we can hardly explain by supposing them to be modifications of instincts necessary for the preservation of the species in a wild state. When such remarkable habits appear in races of this species we may reasonably conjecture that they were given with no other view than for the use of man and the preservation of the dog, which thus obtains protection.

Attributes of animals in their relation to man.—These abilities, along with the behaviors and traits that the shepherd's dog and many others inherit, seem to be so unique and extensive that we can hardly explain them as just modifications of instincts necessary for survival in the wild. When such extraordinary behaviors emerge in different breeds of this species, it's reasonable to assume that they were developed solely for the benefit of humans and the preservation of the dog, which in turn gains protection.

As a general rule, I fully agree with M. F. Cuvier, that, in studying the habits of animals, we must attempt, as far as possible, to refer their domestic qualities to modifications of instincts which are implanted in them in a state of nature; and that writer has successfully pointed out, in an admirable essay on the domestication of the mammalia818, the true 595 origin of many dispositions which are vulgarly attributed to the influence of education alone. But we should go too far if we did not admit that some of the qualities of particular animals and plants may have been given solely with a view to the connection which it was foreseen would exist between them and man—especially when we see that connexion to be in many cases so intimate, that the greater number, and sometimes, as in the case of the camel, all the individuals of the species which exist on the earth are in subjection to the human race.

As a general rule, I completely agree with M. F. Cuvier that when studying animal behavior, we should try to trace their domestic traits back to the instincts they have in the wild. That author has effectively argued in an excellent essay on the domestication of mammals818 the true sources of many characteristics that are often wrongly attributed solely to the effects of training. However, we would be going too far if we didn't acknowledge that some traits of specific animals and plants may have been developed specifically for the relationship they have with humans—especially when we see that connection is often so close that in many cases, and sometimes, as with camels, all individuals of a species are under human control.

We can perceive in a multitude of animals, especially in some of the parasitic tribes, that certain instincts and organs are conferred for the purpose of defence or attack against some other species. Now if we are reluctant to suppose the existence of similar relations between man and the instincts of many of the inferior animals, we adopt an hypothesis no less violent, though in the opposite extreme to that which has led some to imagine the whole animate and inanimate creation to have been made solely for the support, gratification, and instruction of mankind.

We can see in many animals, especially in some parasitic species, that certain instincts and organs are developed for the purpose of defense or attack against other species. If we hesitate to believe that similar relationships exist between humans and the instincts of many lower animals, we are embracing an assumption that is just as extreme, but in the opposite direction, as those who think that all living and non-living things were created solely for the support, enjoyment, and education of humanity.

Many species, most hostile to our persons or property, multiply, in spite of our efforts to repress them; others, on the contrary, are intentionally augmented many hundred fold in number by our exertions. In such instances, we must imagine the relative resources of man, and of species friendly or inimical to him, to have been prospectively calculated and adjusted. To withhold assent to this supposition, would be to refuse what we must grant in respect to the economy of nature in every other part of the organic creation; for the various species of contemporary plants and animals have obviously their relative forces, nicely balanced, and their respective tastes, passions, and instincts so contrived, that they are all in perfect harmony with each other. In no other manner could it happen that each species, surrounded, as it is, by countless dangers, should be enabled to maintain its ground for periods of considerable duration.

Many species, most of which are a threat to our well-being or belongings, continue to thrive despite our attempts to control them; others, on the other hand, are intentionally increased in number many times over by our efforts. In these cases, we should consider that the relative resources of humans and species that are friendly or hostile to us have likely been calculated and adjusted in advance. To refuse to accept this idea would mean denying what we must acknowledge about the balance of nature in every other part of the natural world; the various species of plants and animals we see today obviously have their relative strengths finely tuned, and their respective preferences, desires, and instincts are arranged so that they exist in perfect harmony with one another. Without this balance, it would be impossible for each species, facing numerous threats, to sustain its existence for significant periods.

The docility of the individuals of some of our domestic species, extending, as it does, to attainments foreign to their natural habits and faculties, may, perhaps, have been conferred with a view to their association with man. But, lest species should be thereby made to vary indefinitely, we find that such habits are never transmissible by generation.

The submissiveness of some of our domesticated species, which allows them to learn behaviors that are not part of their natural instincts, may have been developed to help them coexist with humans. However, to prevent endless variations in species, we see that these learned behaviors are not passed down through generations.

A pig has been trained to hunt and point game with great activity and steadiness819; and other learned individuals, of the same species, have been taught to spell; but such fortuitous acquirements never become hereditary, for they have no relation whatever to the exigencies of the animal in a wild state, and cannot, therefore, be developments of any instinctive propensities.

A pig has been trained to hunt and point out game with impressive energy and focus819; and other smart pigs have learned to spell; however, these random skills are never passed down through generations because they are unrelated to the needs of the animal in the wild, and therefore can't be considered developments of any natural instincts.

Influence of domestication.—An animal in domesticity, says M. F. 596 Cuvier, is not essentially in a different situation, in regard to the feeling of restraint, from one left to itself. It lives in society without constraint, because, without doubt, it was a social animal; and it conforms itself to the will of man, because it had a chief, to which, in a wild state, it would have yielded obedience. There is nothing in its new situation that is not conformable to its propensities; it is satisfying its wants by submission to a master, and makes no sacrifice of its natural inclinations. All the social animals, when left to themselves, form herds more or less numerous; and all the individuals of the same herd know each other, are mutually attached, and will not allow a strange individual to join them. In a wild state, moreover, they obey some individual, which, by its superiority, has become the chief of the herd. Our domestic species had, originally, this sociability of disposition; and no solitary species, however easy it may be to tame it, has yet afforded true domestic races. We merely, therefore, develope, to our own advantage, propensities which propel the individuals of certain species to draw near to their fellows.

Influence of domestication.—An animal in domestication, says M. F. 596 Cuvier, is not fundamentally in a different situation regarding the feeling of restraint compared to one that is wild. It lives in community without constraint because it was naturally a social animal; it follows the will of humans because it had a leader to whom it would have submitted in the wild. There's nothing in its new environment that contradicts its tendencies; it fulfills its needs by obeying a master without sacrificing its natural instincts. All social animals, when left alone, form herds of various sizes, and all the members of the same herd recognize one another, develop bonds, and will not allow an outsider to join them. In the wild, they also follow a leader who, by virtue of being stronger or more capable, becomes the head of the herd. Our domestic species originally had this sociable nature, and no solitary species, no matter how easy it may be to tame it, has ever produced true domesticated breeds. Therefore, we simply enhance, for our own benefit, the tendencies that drive certain species to come together with their kind.

The sheep which we have reared is induced to follow us, as it would be led to follow the flock among which it was brought up; and, when individuals of gregarious species have been accustomed to one master, it is he alone whom they acknowledge as their chief—he only whom they obey. "The elephant allows himself to be directed only by the carnac whom he has adopted; the dog itself, reared in solitude with its master, manifests a hostile disposition towards all others; and every body knows how dangerous it is to be in the midst of a herd of cows, in pasturages that are little frequented, when they have not at their head the keeper who takes care of them.

The sheep we've raised follows us like it would follow the flock it grew up with. When animals that usually live in groups get used to one handler, they only recognize that person as their leader and obey them. For example, an elephant will only follow the mahout he has bonded with, and a dog raised alone with its owner can become hostile towards anyone else. Everyone knows how risky it is to be among a herd of cows in less frequented pastures if they're not led by the caretaker responsible for them.

"Every thing, therefore, tends to convince us, that formerly men were only with regard to the domestic animals, what those who are particularly charged with the care of them still are—namely, members of the society which these animals form among themselves; and, that they are only distinguished, in the general mass, by the authority which they have been enabled to assume from their superiority of intellect. Thus, every social animal which recognizes man as a member, and as the chief of its herd, is a domestic animal. It might even be said, that, from the moment when such an animal admits man as a member of its society, it is domesticated, as man could not enter into such society without becoming the chief of it."820

"Everything, therefore, suggests that in the past, humans were to domestic animals what those specifically responsible for their care still are—members of the society that these animals have among themselves; and they are only distinguished, in the broader group, by the authority that they have gained from their superior intelligence. Therefore, any social animal that recognizes humans as members and leaders of their group is considered a domestic animal. It could even be argued that from the moment such an animal accepts a human as part of its society, it is domesticated, as a human could not join that society without becoming its leader." 820

But the ingenious author whose observations I have here cited, admits that the obedience which the individuals of many domestic species yield indifferently to every person, is without analogy in any state of things which could exist previously to their subjugation by man. Each troop of wild horses, it is true, has some stallion for its chief, who draws after him all the individuals of which the herd is composed; but when a domesticated horse has passed from hand to hand, 597 and has served several masters, he becomes equally docile towards any person, and is subjected to the whole human race. It seems fair to presume that the capability in the instinct of the horse to be thus modified, was given to enable the species to render greater services to man; and, perhaps, the facility with which many other acquired characters become hereditary in various races of the horse, may be explicable only on a like supposition. The amble, for example, a pace to which the domestic races in some parts of Spanish America are exclusively trained, has, in the course of several generations, become hereditary, and is assumed by all the young colts before they are broken in.821

But the clever author whose insights I've referenced here acknowledges that the obedience shown by many domestic animal species to anyone is unlike anything in situations that existed before humans tamed them. Each group of wild horses does have a stallion as its leader, who has the herd following him; however, when a domesticated horse changes hands and has had several owners, it becomes equally obedient to any person and submits to all humans. It's reasonable to assume that the horse's ability to adapt its instincts this way was given to help the species serve humans better; and maybe the ease with which many other learned traits become passed down in different horse breeds can only be explained with a similar idea. For instance, the amble, a gait that domestic breeds in certain areas of Spanish America are specifically trained for, has become hereditary over several generations and is adopted by all young colts before they are trained.821

It seems, also, reasonable to conclude, that the power bestowed on the horse, the dog, the ox, the sheep, the cat, and many species of domestic fowls, of supporting almost every climate, was given expressly to enable them to follow man throughout all parts of the globe, in order that we might obtain their services, and they our protection. If it be objected that the elephant which, by the union of strength, intelligence, and docility, can render the greatest services to mankind, is incapable of living in any but the warmest latitudes, we may observe that the quantity of vegetable food required by this quadruped would render its maintenance in the temperate zones too costly, and in the arctic impossible.

It seems reasonable to conclude that the ability of the horse, dog, ox, sheep, cat, and many types of domestic birds to thrive in almost every climate was specifically given to allow them to accompany humans all over the world, so we could benefit from their services while they could rely on our protection. If someone argues that the elephant, which, through its strength, intelligence, and trainability, can provide the greatest assistance to humanity, is only able to live in warm climates, we can point out that the amount of plant-based food this animal needs would make keeping it in temperate regions too expensive and in the Arctic impossible.

Among the changes superinduced by man, none appear, at first sight, more remarkable than the perfect tameness of certain domestic races. It is well known that, at however early an age we obtain possession of the young of many unreclaimed races, they will retain, throughout life, a considerable timidity and apprehensiveness of danger; whereas, after one or two generations, the descendants of the same stock will habitually place the most implicit confidence in man. There is good reason, however, to suspect that such changes are not without analogy in a state of nature; or, to speak more correctly, in situations where man has not interfered.

Among the changes brought about by humans, none seem, at first glance, more striking than the complete tameness of certain domesticated breeds. It’s well known that no matter how young we acquire the offspring of many wild breeds, they will maintain a significant level of shyness and fear of danger throughout their lives. In contrast, after just a generation or two, the descendants of the same species will usually trust humans completely. However, there’s good reason to believe that such changes have parallels in nature, or to put it more accurately, in environments where humans haven't interfered.

We learn from Mr. Darwin, that in the Galapagos archipelago, placed directly under the equator, and nearly 600 miles west of the American continent, all the terrestrial birds, as the finches, doves, hawks, and others, are so tame, that they may be killed with a switch. One day, says this author, "a mocking bird alighted on the edge of a pitcher which I held in my hand, and began quietly to sip the water, and allowed me to lift it with the vessel from the ground." Yet formerly, when the first Europeans landed, and found no inhabitants in these islands, the birds were even tamer than now: already they are beginning to acquire that salutary dread of man which in countries long settled is natural even to young birds which have never received any injury. So in the Falkland Islands, both the birds and foxes are entirely without fear of man; whereas, in the adjoining mainland of South 598 America, many of the same species of birds are extremely wild; for there they have for ages been persecuted by the natives.822

Mr. Darwin tells us that in the Galapagos Islands, located right at the equator and nearly 600 miles west of the U.S. mainland, all the land birds, like finches, doves, and hawks, are so friendly that you can easily catch them with a stick. One day, he writes, "a mockingbird landed on the edge of a pitcher I was holding and started sipping the water, letting me lift it along with the pitcher from the ground." However, when the first Europeans arrived and found no people on these islands, the birds were even friendlier than they are now. They are starting to develop a healthy fear of humans, which is something young birds in long-settled areas naturally have, even if they’ve never been harmed. The same goes for the Falkland Islands, where both birds and foxes show no fear of humans; in contrast, many of the same bird species on the nearby mainland of South 598 America are very skittish because they’ve been hunted by the local people for ages.822

Dr. Richardson informs us, in his able history of the habits of the North American animals, that, "in the retired parts of the mountains where the hunters had seldom penetrated, there is no difficulty in approaching the Rocky Mountain sheep, which there exhibit the simplicity of character so remarkable in the domestic species; but where they have been often fired at, they are exceedingly wild, alarm their companions, on the approach of danger, by a hissing noise, and scale the rocks with a speed and agility that baffle pursuit."823

Dr. Richardson tells us, in his insightful history of North American animal habits, that "in the remote areas of the mountains where hunters rarely go, it’s easy to get close to the Rocky Mountain sheep, which show the simple nature that's so notable in domestic animals; however, where they’ve often been shot at, they are extremely skittish, alert their companions to danger with a hissing sound, and climb the rocks with a speed and agility that makes it hard to chase them." 823

It is probable, therefore, that as man, in diffusing himself over the globe, has tamed many wild races, so, also, he has made many tame races wild. Had some of the larger carnivorous beasts, capable of scaling the rocks, made their way into the North American mountains before our hunters, a similar alteration in the instincts of the sheep would doubtless have been brought about.

It’s likely that as humans spread across the planet, they have domesticated many wild species, but they’ve also made some domesticated species wild again. If some of the larger carnivorous animals that could climb rocks had gotten into the North American mountains before our hunters did, it’s clear that similar changes in the instincts of the sheep would have happened.

Wild elephants domesticated in a few years.—No animal affords a more striking illustration of the principal points which I have been endeavouring to establish than the elephant; for, in the first place, the wonderful sagacity with which he accommodates himself to the society of man, and the new habits which he contracts, are not the result of time, nor of modifications produced in the course of many generations. These animals will breed in captivity, as is now ascertained, in opposition to the vulgar opinion of many modern naturalists, and in conformity to that of the ancients Ælian and Columella824: yet it has always been the custom, as the least expensive mode of obtaining them, to capture wild individuals in the forests, usually when full grown; and, in a few years after they are taken—sometimes, it is said, in the space of a few months—their education is completed.

Wild elephants can be tamed in a few years.—No animal demonstrates the key points I've been trying to make better than the elephant. First, the amazing intelligence with which it adapts to human society and the new behaviors it develops are not due to time or changes that happen over many generations. These animals can breed in captivity, as has been confirmed, countering the common belief of many modern naturalists and aligning with the views of the ancient writers Ælian and Columella824: however, it has always been common practice, being the least costly way to acquire them, to capture wild elephants in the forests, usually when they are fully grown; and, within a few years after capture—sometimes, it's said, in just a few months—their training is completed.

Had the whole species been domesticated from an early period in the history of man, like the camel, their superior intelligence would, doubtless, have been attributed to their long and familiar intercourse with the lord of the creation; but we know that a few years is sufficient to bring about this wonderful change of habits; and although the same individual may continue to receive tuition for a century afterwards, yet it makes no farther progress in the general development of its faculties. Were it otherwise, indeed, the animal would soon deserve more than the poet's epithet of "half-reasoning."

Had the entire species been domesticated from an early point in human history, like the camel, their greater intelligence would surely have been seen as a result of their long and close relationship with humans. However, we know that just a few years can lead to this remarkable shift in behavior. Even though the same individual may continue to be trained for a century afterward, it doesn’t make any further progress in developing its abilities. If it were different, then the animal would quickly earn more than just the poet's term of "half-reasoning."

From the authority of our countrymen employed in the late Burmese war, it appears, in corroboration of older accounts, that when elephants are required to execute extraordinary tasks, they may be made to understand that they will receive unusual rewards. Some favourite dainty is shown to them, in the hope of acquiring which the work is done; and so perfectly does the nature of the contract appear to be understood, 599 that the breach of it, on the part of the master, is often attended with danger. In this case, a power has been given to the species to adapt their social instincts to new circumstances with surprising rapidity; but the extent of this change is defined by strict and arbitrary limits. There is no indication of a tendency to continued divergence from certain attributes with which the elephant was originally endued—no ground whatever for anticipating that, in thousands of centuries, any material alteration could ever be effected. All that we can infer from analogy is, that some more useful and peculiar races might probably be formed, if the experiment were fairly tried; and that some individual characteristic, now only casual and temporary, might be perpetuated by generation.

Based on what we've learned from our fellow citizens involved in the recent Burmese war, it confirms earlier reports that when elephants need to perform extraordinary tasks, they can be made to understand that they'll receive special rewards. A favorite treat is shown to them, motivating them to complete the work; and it seems that they perfectly grasp the terms of the deal, 599 as a breach of this agreement by the handler can often pose a risk. In this case, the species has been given the ability to adjust their social instincts to new situations with remarkable speed; however, the scope of this change is bound by strict and arbitrary limits. There's no sign of a tendency to show significant changes from the key traits that elephants originally had—no reason to expect that, even over thousands of centuries, any substantial transformation could occur. What we can gather from analogy is that some more useful and unique breeds might likely emerge if the experiment were conducted thoroughly; and that some individual traits, currently just occasional and temporary, could be passed down through generations.

In all cases, therefore, where the domestic qualities exist in animals, they seem to require no lengthened process for their developement; and they appear to have been wholly denied to some classes, which, from their strength and social disposition, might have rendered great services to man; as, for example, the greater part of the quadrumana. The orang-outang, indeed, which, for its resemblance in form to man, and apparently for no other good reason, has been assumed by Lamarck to be the most perfect of the inferior animals, has been tamed by the savages of Borneo, and made to climb lofty trees, and to bring down the fruit. But he is said to yield to his masters an unwilling obedience, and to be held in subjection only by severe discipline. We know nothing of the faculties of this animal which can suggest the idea that it rivals the elephant in intelligence; much less anything which can countenance the dreams of those who have fancied that it might have been transmuted into the "dominant race." One of the baboons of Sumatra (Simia carpolegus) appears to be more docile, and is frequently trained by the inhabitants to ascend trees, for the purpose of gathering cocoa-nuts; a service in which the animal is very expert. He selects, says Sir Stamford Raffles, the ripe nuts, with great judgment, and pulls no more than he is ordered.825 The capuchin and cacajao monkeys are, according to Humboldt, taught to ascend trees in the same manner, and to throw down fruit on the banks of the lower Orinoco.826

In all cases, where domestic traits are present in animals, they don't seem to need a long process for their development; and some classes seem to have been completely overlooked, which, due to their strength and social nature, could have been very helpful to humans, like many of the primates. For instance, the orangutan, which Lamarck claims to be the most advanced of the lesser animals because of its similarity to humans—though he provides no other convincing reason—has been domesticated by the indigenous people of Borneo, who train it to climb tall trees and gather fruit. However, it reportedly provides its masters with a reluctant compliance and can only be kept in check through strict discipline. We know little about this animal's abilities to suggest that it is as intelligent as an elephant; even less to support the idea that it could have evolved into the "dominant race." One of the baboons from Sumatra (Simia carpolegus) seems to be more trainable and is often taught by locals to climb trees to collect coconuts, a task at which it excels. According to Sir Stamford Raffles, it skillfully picks the ripe nuts and only collects as many as it is instructed to. 825 The capuchin and cacajao monkeys are, according to Humboldt, trained to climb trees in a similar way and throw down fruit along the banks of the lower Orinoco.826

It is for the Lamarckians to explain how it happens that those same savages of Borneo have not themselves acquired, by dint of longing, for many generations, for the power of climbing trees, the elongated arms of the ourang, or even the prehensile tails of some American monkeys: Instead of being reduced to the necessity of subjugating stubborn and untractable brutes, we should naturally have anticipated "that their wants would have excited them to efforts, and that continued efforts would have given rise to new organs;" or rather to the re-acquisition of organs which, in a manner irreconcileable with the principle of the 600 progressive system, have grown obsolete in tribes of men which have such constant need of them.

It’s up to the Lamarckians to explain how the same Borneo savages haven’t developed, through generations of desire for climbing trees, the long arms of the orangutan, or even the prehensile tails seen in some American monkeys. Rather than being forced to dominate stubborn and difficult creatures, we would have expected that “their needs would have driven them to make efforts, and that consistent efforts would have led to the development of new organs;” or rather, the re-acquisition of organs that, in a way incompatible with the principle of the 600 progressive system, have become obsolete in human tribes that consistently require them.

Recapitulation.—It follows, then, from the different facts which have been considered in this chapter, that a short period of time is generally sufficient to effect nearly the whole change which an alteration of external circumstances can bring about in the habits of a species, and that such capacity of accommodation to new circumstances is enjoyed in very different degrees, by different species.

Recapitulation.—Based on the various facts discussed in this chapter, it can be concluded that a brief period is usually enough to make almost all the changes that a shift in external conditions can cause in a species' habits, and that the ability to adapt to new circumstances varies significantly among different species.

Certain qualities appear to be bestowed exclusively with a view to the relations which are destined to exist between different species, and, among others, between certain species and man; but these latter are always so nearly connected with the original habits and propensities of each species in a wild state, that they imply no indefinite capacity of varying from the original type. The acquired habits derived from human tuition are rarely transmitted to the offspring; and when this happens, it is almost universally the case with those merely which have some obvious connexion with the attributes of the species when in a state of independence.

Certain qualities seem to be given specifically for the relationships that are meant to exist between different species, including those between some species and humans. However, these qualities are always closely linked to the original habits and tendencies of each species in the wild, indicating no endless ability to change from the original type. The habits gained from human training are rarely passed on to offspring; and when they are, it usually only happens with those that have a clear connection to the traits of the species in its natural state.


CHAPTER XXXVI.

WHETHER SPECIES HAVE A REAL EXISTENCE IN NATURE—continued.

Phenomena of hybrids—Hunter's opinions—Mules not strictly intermediate between parent species—Hybrid plants—Experiments of Kölreuter and Wiegmann—Vegetable hybrids prolific throughout several generations—Why rare in a wild state—Decundolle on hybrid plants—The phenomena of hybrids confirm the distinctness of species—Theory of the gradation in the intelligence of animals as indicated by the facial angle—Doctrine that certain organs of the fœtus in mammalia assume successively the forms of fish, reptile, and bird—Recapitulation.

Phenomena of hybrids—Hunter's views—Mules aren’t really a true mix between parent species—Hybrid plants—Experiments by Kölreuter and Wiegmann—Plant hybrids thriving over multiple generations—Why they’re uncommon in the wild—Decundolle on hybrid plants—The phenomena of hybrids support the distinctness of species—Theory of the gradation in animal intelligence as shown by facial angles—The idea that certain fetal organs in mammals successively take on the shapes of fish, reptiles, and birds—Recapitulation.

Phenomena of hybrids.—We have yet to consider another class of phenomena, those relating to the production of hybrids, which have been regarded in a very different light with reference to their bearing on the question of the permanent distinctness of species; some naturalists considering them as affording the strongest of all proofs in favor of the reality of species; others, on the contrary, appealing to them as countenancing the opposite doctrine, that all the varieties of organization and instinct now exhibited in the animal and vegetable kingdoms may have been propagated from a small number of original types.

Hybrid Phenomena.—We still need to look at another category of phenomena, those connected to the creation of hybrids, which have been viewed in very different ways regarding their implications for the ongoing distinctness of species. Some naturalists see them as the strongest evidence supporting the reality of species, while others, on the other hand, argue that they support the opposing idea that all the variations in organization and instinct currently seen in the animal and plant kingdoms could have originated from a small number of original types.

In regard to the mammifers and birds it is found that no sexual union will take place between races which are remote from each other in their habits and organization; and it is only in species that are very nearly allied that such unions produce offspring. It may be laid down 601 as a general rule, admitting of very few exceptions among quadrupeds, that the hybrid progeny is sterile; and there seem to be no well authenticated examples of the continuance of the mule race beyond one generation. The principal number of observations and experiments relate to the mixed offspring of the horse and the ass; and in this case it is well established that the he-mule can generate, and the she-mule produce. Such cases occur in Spain and Italy, and much more frequently in the West Indies and New Holland; but these mules have never bred in cold climates, seldom in warm regions, and still more rarely in temperate countries.

In terms of mammals and birds, it's observed that no sexual mating happens between races that are very different in their behaviors and structures; it’s only in species that are closely related that such matings result in offspring. It can generally be stated, with very few exceptions among mammals, that hybrid offspring are sterile; and there don't seem to be any well-documented cases of mules reproducing beyond one generation. Most observations and experiments focus on the hybrid offspring of horses and donkeys; in this case, it is well known that male mules can mate, and female mules can give birth. Such occurrences are found in Spain and Italy, and much more commonly in the West Indies and Australia; however, these mules have never bred in cold climates, rarely in warm areas, and even less frequently in temperate regions. 601

The hybrid offspring of the she-ass and the stallion, the γιννος of Aristotle, and the hinnus of Pliny, differs from the mule, or the offspring of the ass and mare. In both cases, says Buffon, these animals retain more of the dam than of the sire, not only in the magnitude, but in the figure of the body: whereas, in the form of the head, limbs, and tail, they bear a greater resemblance to the sire. The same naturalist infers, from various experiments respecting cross-breeds between the he-goat and ewe, the dog and she-wolf, the goldfinch and canary-bird, that the male transmits his sex to the greatest number, and that the preponderance of males over females exceeds that which prevails where the parents are of the same species.

The hybrid offspring of a female donkey and a stallion, known as the γιννος by Aristotle and the hinnus by Pliny, is different from a mule, which is the result of a male donkey and a female horse. Buffon notes that in both cases, these animals show more traits from the mother than from the father, not just in size but also in body shape. However, in the shape of the head, limbs, and tail, they resemble the father more. The same naturalist concludes from various experiments with cross-breeds such as the male goat and female sheep, the dog and female wolf, and the goldfinch and canary, that the male tends to pass on his sex more frequently, and that there is a higher ratio of males to females than when the parents are of the same species.

Hunter's opinion.—The celebrated John Hunter has observed, that the true distinction of species must ultimately be gathered from their incapacity of propagating with each other, and producing offspring capable of again continuing itself. He was unwilling, however, to admit that the horse and the ass were of the same species, because some rare instances had been adduced of the breeding of mules, although he maintained that the wolf, the dog, and the jackal were all of one species; because he had found, by two experiments, that the dog would breed both with the wolf and the jackal; and that the mule, in each case, would breed again with the dog. In these cases, however, it may be observed, that there was always one parent at least of pure breed, and no proof was obtained that a true hybrid race could be perpetuated; a fact of which I believe no examples are yet recorded, either in regard to mixtures of the horse and ass, or any other of the mammalia.

Hunter's opinion.—The renowned John Hunter noted that the real difference between species should ultimately be determined by their inability to breed with one another and produce offspring that can also reproduce. However, he was hesitant to accept that horses and donkeys were the same species, even though there were some rare cases of mules being born. He insisted that wolves, dogs, and jackals were all the same species because he found, through two experiments, that dogs could mate with both wolves and jackals, and that mules in each instance would be able to breed again with dogs. In these cases, though, it's important to note that at least one parent was always of pure breed, and there was no evidence showing that a true hybrid race could be sustained; I believe there are still no recorded examples of this regarding the breeding of horses and donkeys, or any other mammals.

Should the fact be hereafter ascertained, that two mules can propagate their kind, we must still inquire whether the offspring may not be regarded in the light of a monstrous birth, proceeding from some accidental cause, or, rather, to speak more philosophically, from some general law not yet understood, but which may not be permitted permanently to interfere with those laws of generation by which species may, in general, be prevented from becoming blended. If, for example, we discovered that the progeny of a mule race degenerated greatly, in the first generation, in force, sagacity, or any attribute necessary for its preservation in a state of nature, we might infer that, like a monster, it is a mere temporary and fortuitous variety. Nor does it seem probable that the greater number of such monsters could ever occur unless obtained 602 by art; for, in Hunter's experiments, stratagem or force was, in most instances, employed to bring about the irregular connexion.827

Should it be determined in the future that two mules can reproduce, we still need to investigate whether the offspring can be considered a monstrous birth, resulting from some random cause, or, to put it more philosophically, from some general principle that we don’t fully understand yet, which shouldn’t permanently disrupt the laws of reproduction that usually prevent species from mixing. For instance, if we found that the offspring of a mule breed significantly lost strength, intelligence, or any essential traits needed for survival in the wild in the first generation, we might conclude that it is just a temporary and random variation, much like a monster. It also seems unlikely that many such monsters could occur unless artificially created; in Hunter's experiments, trickery or force was often used to induce the irregular connection.602

Mules not strictly intermediate between the parent species.—It seems rarely to happen that the mule offspring is truly intermediate in character between the two parents. Thus Hunter mentions that, in his experiments, one of the hybrid pups resembled the wolf much more than the rest of the litter; and we are informed by Wiegmann, that, in a litter lately obtained in the Royal Menagerie at Berlin, from a white pointer and a she-wolf, two of the cubs resembled the common wolf-dog, but the third was like a pointer with hanging ears.

Mules not strictly intermediate between the parent species.—It rarely happens that mule offspring are genuinely intermediate in characteristics between the two parents. For example, Hunter notes that in his experiments, one of the hybrid pups looked much more like a wolf than the others in the litter. Also, Wiegmann tells us that in a recent litter from the Royal Menagerie in Berlin, produced by a white pointer and a she-wolf, two of the cubs resembled a common wolf-dog, while the third looked like a pointer with floppy ears.

There is undoubtedly a very close analogy between these phenomena and those presented by the intermixture of distinct races of the same species, both in the inferior animals and in man. Dr. Prichard, in his "Physical History of Mankind," cites examples where the peculiarities of the parents have been transmitted very unequally to the offspring; as where children, entirely white, or perfectly black, have sprung from the union of the European and the negro. Sometimes the colour or other peculiarities of one parent, after having failed to show themselves in the immediate progeny, reappear in a subsequent generation; as where a white child is born of two black parents, the grandfather having been a white.828

There is definitely a strong similarity between these phenomena and what happens when different races of the same species mix, both in animals and in humans. Dr. Prichard, in his "Physical History of Mankind," provides examples where the traits of the parents have been passed down very unevenly to their children; for instance, children who are completely white or entirely black can come from the union of a European and a Black person. Sometimes, the traits or characteristics of one parent, which initially don't appear in their immediate children, show up in later generations; like when a white child is born to two Black parents, with the grandfather being white.828

The same author judiciously observes that, if different species mixed their breed, and hybrid races were often propagated, the animal world would soon present a scene of confusion; its tribes would be every where blended together, and we should perhaps find more hybrid creatures than genuine and uncorrupted races.829

The same author wisely points out that if different species interbred and hybrid races were frequently produced, the animal kingdom would quickly become chaotic; its groups would be mixed all over, and we might end up seeing more hybrids than pure and untainted breeds.829

Hybrid plants.Kölreuter's experiments.—The history of the vegetable kingdom has been thought to afford more decisive evidence in favour of the theory of the formation of new and permanent species from hybrid stocks. The first accurate experiments in illustration of this curious subject appear to have been made by Kölreuter, who obtained a hybrid from two species of tobacco, Nicotiana rustica and N. paniculata, which differ greatly in the shape of their leaves, the colour of the corolla, and the height of the stem. The stigma of a plant of N. rustica was impregnated with the pollen of a plant of N. paniculata. The seed ripened, and produced a hybrid which was intermediate between the two parents, and which, like all the hybrids which this botanist brought up, had imperfect stamens. He afterwards impregnated this hybrid with the pollen of N. paniculata, and obtained plants which much more resembled the last. This he continued through several generations, until, by due perseverance, he actually changed the Nicotiana rustica into the Nicotiana paniculata.

Hybrid plants.Kölreuter's experiments.—The history of the plant kingdom has been seen as providing strong evidence for the idea that new and stable species can form from hybrid origins. The first precise experiments demonstrating this intriguing topic were conducted by Kölreuter, who created a hybrid from two species of tobacco, Nicotiana rustica and N. paniculata, which are quite different in their leaf shape, corolla color, and stem height. The stigma of a N. rustica plant was fertilized with the pollen from a N. paniculata plant. The seeds matured and produced a hybrid that was a mix of the two parents, and like all the hybrids that this botanist raised, it had underdeveloped stamens. He later fertilized this hybrid with the pollen from a N. paniculata plant again, producing plants that resembled the latter more closely. He continued this process over several generations, and through diligent effort, he successfully transformed Nicotiana rustica into Nicotiana paniculata.

The plan of impregnation adopted, was the cutting off of the anthers 603 of the plant intended for fructification before they had shed pollen, and then laying on foreign pollen upon the stigma.

The method chosen for fertilization involved removing the anthers 603 from the plant meant for reproduction before they released any pollen, and then applying foreign pollen to the stigma.

Wiegmann's experiments.—The same experiment has since been repeated with success by Wiegmann, who found that he could bring back the hybrids to the exact likeness of either parent, by crossing them a sufficient number of times.

Wiegmann's experiments.—The same experiment has since been successfully repeated by Wiegmann, who discovered that he could restore the hybrids to look exactly like either parent by crossing them enough times.

The blending of the characters of the parent stocks, in many other of Wiegmann's experiments, was complete; the colour and shape of the leaves and flowers, and even the scent, being intermediate, as in the offspring of the two species of verbascum. An intermarriage, also, between the common onion and the leek (Allium cepa and A. porrum) gave a mule plant, which, in the character of its leaves and flowers, approached most nearly to the garden onion, but had the elongated bulbous root and smell of the leek.

The mixing of the traits from the parent plants in many of Wiegmann's experiments was complete; the color and shape of the leaves and flowers, and even the scent, were intermediate, just like in the offspring of the two species of verbascum. Additionally, a cross between the common onion and the leek (Allium cepa and A. porrum) resulted in a hybrid plant that closely resembled the garden onion in terms of its leaves and flowers but had the elongated bulbous root and smell of the leek.

The same botanist remarks, that vegetable hybrids, when not strictly intermediate, more frequently approach the female than the male parent species; but they never exhibit characters foreign to both. A re-cross with one of the original stocks generally causes the mule plant to revert towards that stock; but this is not always the case, the offspring sometimes continuing to exhibit the character of a full hybrid.

The same botanist notes that plant hybrids, when they're not strictly in between, often resemble the female parent species more than the male; but they never show traits that neither parent has. A re-cross with one of the original species usually causes the hybrid plant to return to that species; however, this isn’t always true, as the offspring may still show characteristics of a full hybrid.

In general, the success attending the production and perpetuity of hybrids among plants depends, as in the animal kingdom, on the degree of proximity between the species intermarried. If their organization be very remote, impregnation never takes place; if somewhat less distant, seeds are formed, but always imperfect and sterile. The next degree of relationship yields hybrid seedlings, but these are barren; and it is only when the parent species are very nearly allied that the hybrid race may be perpetuated for several generations. Even in this case the best authenticated examples seem confined to the crossing of hybrids with individuals of pure breed. In none of the experiments most accurately detailed does it appear that both the parents were mules.

In general, the success of producing and maintaining hybrids in plants, like in animals, depends on how closely related the interbreeding species are. If the species are too distantly related, no fertilization occurs. If they are a bit closer, seeds can form, but they are usually incomplete and sterile. A closer relationship will produce hybrid seedlings, but these will be infertile. It’s only when the parent species are very closely related that the hybrid offspring can be sustained for several generations. Even then, the best-documented examples seem to involve crossing hybrids with individuals of the purebred species. In none of the most carefully recorded experiments does it seem that both parents were mules.

Wiegmann diversified as much as possible his mode of bringing about these irregular unions among plants. He often sowed parallel rows, near to each other, of the species from which he desired to breed; and, instead of mutilating, after Kölreuter's fashion, the plants of one of the parent stocks, he merely washed the pollen off their anthers. The branches of the plants in each row were then gently bent towards each other and intertwined; so that the wind, and numerous insects, as they passed from the flowers of one to those of the other species, carried the pollen and produced fecundation.

Wiegmann tried to diversify as much as possible in how he created these unusual plant unions. He often planted parallel rows close together of the species he wanted to breed. Instead of cutting the plants from one of the parent species, like Kölreuter did, he simply washed the pollen off their anthers. He then gently bent the branches of the plants in each row towards each other and intertwined them, allowing the wind and various insects to transfer pollen from the flowers of one species to the other, leading to fertilization.

Vegetable hybrids why rare in a wild slate.—The same observer saw a good exemplification of the manner in which hybrids may be formed in a state of nature. Some wallflowers and pinks had been growing in a garden, in a dry sunny situation, and their stigmas had been ripened so as to be moist, and to absorb pollen with avidity, although their anthers were not yet developed. These stigmas became impregnated by pollen blown from some other adjacent plants of the same species; but had 604 they been of different species, and not too remote in their organization, mule races must have resulted.

Why Vegetable Hybrids Are Rare in the Wild.—The same observer witnessed a clear example of how hybrids can form in nature. Some wallflowers and pinks were growing in a garden, positioned in a dry, sunny spot, and their stigmas had ripened to be moist and eager to absorb pollen, even though their anthers hadn’t developed yet. These stigmas became fertilized by pollen carried from other nearby plants of the same species; however, if they had been from different species, and not too distantly related, hybrids would have emerged.

When, indeed, we consider how busily some insects have been shown to be engaged in conveying anther-dust from flower to flower, especially bees, flower-eating beetles, and the like, it seems a most enigmatical problem how it can happen that promiscuous alliances between distinct species are not perpetually occurring.

When we think about how busy some insects are in transferring pollen from flower to flower, especially bees and flower-eating beetles, it really raises a puzzling question: why aren’t there constant random hybrids forming between different species?

How continually do we observe the bees diligently employed in collecting the red and yellow powder by which the stamens of flowers are covered, loading it on their hind legs, and carrying it to their hive for the purpose of feeding their young! In thus providing for their own progeny, these insects assist materially the process of fructification.830 Few persons need be reminded that the stamens in certain plants grow on different blossoms from the pistils; and unless the summit of the pistil be touched with the fertilizing dust, the fruit does not swell, nor the seed arrive at maturity. It is by the help of bees chiefly, that the development of the fruit of many such species is secured, the powder which they have collected from the stamens being unconsciously left by them in visiting the pistils.

How often do we see bees busily collecting the red and yellow powder that covers the stamens of flowers, loading it onto their hind legs, and carrying it back to their hive to feed their young? In taking care of their offspring, these insects play a crucial role in the process of pollination.830 Few people need to be reminded that in certain plants, the stamens are found on different flowers from the pistils, and unless the top of the pistil is touched with the fertilizing pollen, the fruit won’t develop, or the seeds won’t mature. It’s mainly thanks to bees that the fruit of many such species is able to develop, as the pollen they collect from the stamens is unknowingly deposited on the pistils during their visits.

How often, during the heat of a summer's day, do we see the males of diœcious plants, such as the yew-tree, standing separate from the females, and sending off into the air, upon the slightest breath of wind, clouds of buoyant pollen! That the zephyr should so rarely intervene to fecundate the plants of one species with the anther-dust of others, seems almost to realize the converse of the miracle believed by the credulous herdsmen of the Lusitanian mares—

How often, on a hot summer day, do we see male dioecious plants, like the yew tree, standing apart from the females and releasing clouds of lightweight pollen into the air with just the slightest gust of wind! The fact that a gentle breeze rarely mixes the pollen from one species with that of another seems almost to echo the opposite of the miracle believed by the gullible herders of the Lusitanian mares—

All turned towards the West Wind, they stand on high cliffs. Except for the light breezes: and often without any Wives, heavy with wind, amazing to tell.831

But, in the first place, it appears that there is a natural aversion in plants, as well as in animals, to irregular sexual unions; and in most of the successful experiments in the animal and vegetable world, some violence has been used in order to procure impregnation. The stigma imbibes, slowly and reluctantly, the granules of the pollen of another species, even when it is abundantly covered with it; and if it happen that, during this period, ever so slight a quantity of the anther-dust of its own species alight upon it, this is instantly absorbed, and the effect of the foreign pollen destroyed. Besides, it does not often happen that the male and female organs of fructification, in different species, arrive at a state of maturity at precisely the same time. Even where such synchronism does prevail, so that a cross impregnation is effected, the chances are very numerous against the establishment of a hybrid race.

But first, it seems that both plants and animals have a natural aversion to irregular sexual unions; in most successful experiments in the animal and plant worlds, some form of force has been used to achieve fertilization. The stigma slowly and hesitantly takes in the pollen grains from another species, even when it’s heavily coated with them; and if even a tiny amount of pollen from its own species happens to land on it during this time, it is quickly absorbed, neutralizing the effect of the foreign pollen. Moreover, it's not common for the male and female reproductive organs of different species to mature at exactly the same time. Even when such timing does occur, and cross-fertilization happens, there are numerous obstacles against the formation of a stable hybrid race.

If we consider the vegetable kingdom generally, it must be recollected that even of the seeds which are well ripened, a great part are either 605 eaten by insects, birds, and other animals, or decay for want of room and opportunity to germinate. Unhealthy plants are the first which are cut off by causes prejudicial to the species, being usually stifled by more vigorous individuals of their own kind. If, therefore, the relative fecundity or hardiness of hybrids be in the least degree inferior, they cannot maintain their footing for many generations, even if they were ever produced beyond one generation in a wild state. In the universal struggle for existence, the right of the strongest eventually prevails; and the strength and durability of a race depend mainly on its prolificness, in which hybrids are acknowledged to be deficient.

If we look at the plant kingdom as a whole, we need to remember that a significant number of well-ripened seeds are either 605 eaten by insects, birds, and other animals or rot because there isn’t enough space or opportunity for them to sprout. Unhealthy plants are the first to be eliminated by factors harmful to the species, as they are usually overshadowed by stronger members of their own kind. Therefore, if hybrids are even slightly less fertile or resilient, they won't survive for many generations, even if they could exist beyond one generation in the wild. In the ongoing struggle for survival, the strongest ultimately win; and the strength and longevity of a species largely depend on its ability to reproduce, in which hybrids are known to be lacking.

Centaurea hybrida, a plant which never bears seed, and is supposed to be produced by the frequent intermixture of two well-known species of Centaurea, grows wild upon a hill near Turin. Ranunculus lacerus, also sterile, has been produced accidentally at Grenoble, and near Paris, by the union of two Ranunculi; but this occurred in gardens.832

Centaurea hybrida, a plant that never produces seeds and is thought to come from the frequent mixing of two well-known Centaurea species, grows wild on a hill near Turin. Ranunculus lacerus, which is also sterile, has been accidentally created in gardens at Grenoble and near Paris through the union of two Ranunculi.832

Mr. Herbert's experiments.—Mr. Herbert, in one of his ingenious papers on mule plants, endeavors to account for their non-occurrence in a state of nature, from the circumstance that all the combinations that were likely to occur have already been made many centuries ago, and have formed the various species of botanists; but in our gardens, he says, whenever species, having a certain degree of affinity to each other, are transported from different countries, and brought for the first time into contact, they give rise to hybrid species.833 But we have no data, as yet, to warrant the conclusion, that a single permanent hybrid race has ever been formed, even in gardens, by the intermarriage of two allied species brought from distant habitations. Until some fact of this kind is fairly established, and a new species, capable of perpetuating itself in a state of perfect independence of man, can be pointed out, it seems reasonable to call in question entirely this hypothetical source of new species. That varieties do sometimes spring up from cross-breeds, in a natural way, can hardly be doubted; but they probably die out even more rapidly than races propagated by grafts or layers.

Mr. Herbert's experiments.—Mr. Herbert, in one of his clever papers on hybrid plants, tries to explain why they don’t naturally occur, noting that all possible combinations likely happened many centuries ago, leading to the various species cataloged by botanists. However, he observes that in our gardens, when species that are somewhat related are brought together from different countries for the first time, they often create hybrid species.833 But we don’t have enough evidence yet to support the idea that a single stable hybrid race has ever formed, even in gardens, through the interbreeding of two related species from far-off places. Until we can establish a fact like this and identify a new species that can thrive independently of human intervention, it seems fair to question this hypothetical source of new species entirely. It’s hard to deny that varieties sometimes emerge from natural cross-breeding, but they likely vanish even faster than races produced through grafting or layering.

Opinion of De Candolle.—De Candolle, whose opinion on a philosophical question of this kind deserves the greatest attention, has observed, in his Essay on Botanical Geography, that the varieties of plants range themselves under two general heads: those produced by external circumstances, and those formed by hybridity. After adducing various arguments to show that neither of these causes can explain the permanent diversity of plants indigenous in different regions, he says, in regard to the crossing of races, "I can perfectly comprehend without altogether sharing the opinion, that, where many species of the same genera occur near together, hybrid species may be formed, and I am aware that the great number of species of certain genera which are found in particular regions may be explained in this manner; but I am unable to conceive how any one can regard the same explanation as applicable to species 606 which live naturally at great distances. If the three larches, for example, now known in the world, lived in the same localities, I might then believe that one of them was the produce of the crossing of the two others; but I never could admit that the Siberian species has been produced by the crossing of those of Europe and America. I see, then, that there exist in organized beings, permanent differences which cannot be referred to any one of the actual causes of variation, and these differences are what constitute species."834

Opinion of De Candolle.—De Candolle, whose perspective on a philosophical issue like this is worth significant consideration, noted in his Essay on Botanical Geography that the varieties of plants can be categorized into two main groups: those influenced by external conditions and those created through hybridization. After providing various arguments to show that neither of these factors can account for the lasting diversity of plants native to different areas, he states, regarding the mixing of species, "I can fully understand, though I don't entirely agree with, the view that when many species of the same genus exist close together, hybrid species might arise. I'm aware that the large number of species in certain genera found in specific regions can be explained this way; however, I find it hard to see how anyone can apply the same reasoning to species that live naturally far apart. For instance, if the three larch species currently recognized lived in the same areas, I could then believe that one was a result of crossing the other two; yet I could never accept that the Siberian species came from crossing those of Europe and America. Therefore, I see that there are permanent differences in organized beings that can't be attributed to any of the known causes of variation, and these differences are what define species."606

Reality of species confirmed by the phenomena of hybrids.—The most decisive arguments perhaps, amongst many others, against the probability of the derivation of permanent species from cross-breeds, are to be drawn from the fact alluded to by De Candolle, of species having a close affinity to each other occurring in distinct botanical provinces, or countries inhabited by groups of distinct species of indigenous plants; for in this case naturalists, who are not prepared to go the whole length of the transmutationists, are under the necessity of admitting that, in some cases, species which approach very near to each other in their characters, were so created from their origin; an admission fatal to the idea of its being a general law of nature that a few original types only should be formed, and that all intermediate races should spring from the intermixture of those stocks.

The reality of species is proven by hybrid phenomena.—One of the strongest arguments against the likelihood of permanent species arising from crossbreeds comes from the observation noted by De Candolle, that closely related species can be found in different botanical regions or countries populated by distinct species of native plants. In this situation, naturalists who are not fully on board with transmutation theories must accept that, in some cases, species that are very similar in their characteristics were created as such from the start. This acknowledgment undermines the idea that it is a universal law of nature for only a few original types to exist, with all the intermediate varieties arising from the mixing of these ancestral lines.

This notion, indeed, is wholly at variance with all that we know of hybrid generation; for the phenomena entitle us to affirm, that had the types been at first somewhat distinct, no cross-breeds would ever have been produced, much less those prolific races which we now recognize as distinct species.

This idea is completely at odds with everything we understand about hybrid generation; the evidence allows us to conclude that if the types had initially been somewhat different, no crossbreeds would have ever been produced, let alone the many prolific races that we now identify as separate species.

In regard, moreover, to the permanent propagation of hybrid races among animals, insuperable difficulties present themselves, when we endeavor to conceive the blending together of the different instincts and propensities of two species, so as to insure the preservation of the intermediate race. The common mule, when obtained by human art, may be protected by the power of man; but, in a wild state, it would not have precisely the same wants either as the horse or the ass; and if in consequence of some difference of this kind, it strayed from the herd, it would soon be hunted down by beasts of prey, and destroyed.

In terms of the ongoing breeding of hybrid animals, there are significant challenges when we try to imagine how the different instincts and tendencies of two species can come together to ensure the survival of the hybrid offspring. The common mule, created by human intervention, can be supported by humans; however, in the wild, it wouldn't have the exact needs of either a horse or a donkey. If, due to some difference in these needs, it got separated from the group, it would quickly be hunted by predators and killed.

If we take some genus of insects, such as the bee, we find that each of the numerous species has some difference in its habits, its mode of collecting honey, or constructing its dwelling, or providing for its young, and other particulars. In the case of the common hive bee, the workers are described, by Kirby and Spence, as being endowed with no less than thirty distinct instincts.835 So also we find that, amongst a most numerous class of spiders, there are nearly as many different modes of spinning their webs as there are species. When we recollect how complicated are the relations of these instincts with co-existing species, both 607 of the animal and vegetable kingdoms, it is scarcely possible to imagine that a bastard race could spring from the union of two of these species, and retain just so much of the qualities of each parent stock as to preserve its ground in spite of the dangers which surround it.

If we look at a group of insects like bees, we see that each of the many species has its own unique habits, ways of collecting honey, building nests, or taking care of their young, among other details. In the case of the common hive bee, Kirby and Spence describe the workers as having no less than thirty distinct instincts.835 Similarly, among a vast number of spider species, there are almost as many different ways to spin webs as there are species. Considering how complex the relationships of these instincts are with various coexisting species in both the animal and plant kingdoms, it's hard to imagine that a mixed race could emerge from the union of two of these species and retain just enough qualities from each parent to survive despite the dangers around it.

We might also ask, if a few generic types alone have been created among insects, and the intermediate species have proceeded from hybridity, where are those original types, combining, as they ought to do, the elements of all the instincts which have made their appearance in the numerous derivative races? So also in regard to animals of all classes, and of plants; if species are in general of hybrid origin, where are the stocks which combine in themselves the habits, properties, and organs, of which all the intervening species ought to afford us mere modifications?

We might also wonder, if only a few basic types have been created among insects, and the species in between have come from hybridization, where are those original types that should combine all the instincts present in the many different descendant races? The same goes for animals of all kinds and for plants; if most species are generally of hybrid origin, where are the foundational types that should encompass the behaviors, traits, and features that all the intermediate species should simply reflect?

Recapitulation of the arguments from hybrids.—I shall now conclude this subject by summing up, in a few words, the results to which I have been led by the consideration of the phenomena of hybrids. It appears that the aversion of individuals of distinct species to the sexual union is common to animals and plants; and that it is only when the species approach near to each other in their organization and habits, that any offspring are produced from their connexion. Mules are of extremely rare occurrence in a state of nature, and no examples are yet known of their having procreated in a wild state. But it has been proved, that hybrids are not universally sterile, provided the parent stocks have a near affinity to each other, although the continuation of the mixed race, for several generations, appears hitherto to have been obtained only by crossing the hybrids with individuals of pure species; an experiment which by no means bears out the hypothesis that a true hybrid race could ever be permanently established.

Summary of the arguments regarding hybrids.—I will now wrap up this topic by briefly summarizing the conclusions I've reached after examining the phenomena of hybrids. It seems that the reluctance of individuals from different species to mate is common among both animals and plants. Only when species are closely related in their structure and behaviors do we see any offspring resulting from their connection. Mules are very rarely found in the wild, and there have been no confirmed instances of them reproducing in natural settings. However, it has been shown that hybrids are not always sterile, as long as the parent species are closely related. Still, maintaining a mixed hybrid lineage for several generations appears to have only been possible by breeding hybrids with individuals from pure species, an approach that does not support the idea that a stable hybrid race could ever be permanently established.

Hence we may infer, that aversion to sexual intercourse is, in general, a good test of the distinctness of original stocks, or of species; and the procreation of hybrids is a proof of the near affinity of species. Perhaps, hereafter, the number of generations for which hybrids may be continued, before the race dies out (for it seems usually to degenerate rapidly), may afford the zoologist and botanist an experimental test of the difference in the degree of affinity of allied species.

Therefore, we can conclude that a dislike for sexual intercourse is generally a good indicator of the distinctness of original stocks or of species; and the creation of hybrids is evidence of the close relationship between species. In the future, the number of generations that hybrids can persist before dying out (which typically seems to happen quickly) may provide zoologists and botanists with a practical way to test the differences in the degree of relatedness among closely related species.

I may also remark, that if it could have been shown that a single permanent species had ever been produced by hybridity (of which there is no satisfactory proof), it might certainly have lent some countenance to the notions of the ancients respecting the gradual deterioration of created things, but none whatever to Lamarck's theory of their progressive perfectibility, for observations have hitherto shown that there is a tendency in mule animals and plants to degenerate in organization.

I should point out that if it could be proven that a single permanent species had ever been created through hybridization (of which there is no solid evidence), it might have supported the ancient beliefs about the gradual decline of created things. However, it wouldn't support Lamarck's theory of progressive perfection, as observations so far have shown that mules and hybrid plants tend to degenerate in their organization.

It was before remarked, that the theory of progressive development arose partly from an attempt to ingraft the doctrines of the transmutationists upon one of the most popular generalizations in geology. But we have seen in the ninth chapter, that the modern researches of geologists have broken at many points the chain of evidence once supposed to exist 608 in favor of the doctrine, that, at each successive period in the earth's history, animals and plants of a higher grade, or more complex organization, have been created. The recent origin of man, and the absence of all signs of any rational being holding an analogous relation to former states of the animate world, affords one, and perhaps in the present state of science the only argument of much weight in support of the hypothesis of a progressive scheme; but none whatever in favor of the fancied evolution of one species out of another.

It has been previously pointed out that the theory of progressive development partly came from an effort to merge the beliefs of transmutationists with one of the most well-known theories in geology. However, as we have seen in the ninth chapter, modern geologists have identified several weaknesses in the evidence that was once thought to support the idea that, during each successive period in the earth's history, more advanced animals and plants have emerged. The relatively recent origin of humans, along with the lack of any signs of rational beings that resemble earlier forms of life, provides one, and perhaps currently the only strong argument for the hypothesis of a progressive development scheme; but it offers no support for the imagined evolution of one species from another.

Theory of the gradation of intellect as shown by the facial angle.—When the celebrated anatomist, Camper, first attempted to estimate the degrees of sagacity of different animals, and of the races of man, by the measurement of the facial angle, some speculators were bold enough to affirm that certain Simiæ, or apes, differed as little from the more savage races of men, as those do from the human race in general; and that a scale might be traced from "apes with foreheads villanous low" to the African variety of the human species, and from that to the European. The facial angle was measured by drawing a line from the prominent centre of the forehead to the most advanced part of the lower jaw-bone, and observing the angle which it made with the horizontal line; and it was affirmed, that there was a regular series of such angles from birds to the mammalia.

Theory of the gradation of intellect as shown by the facial angle.—When the famous anatomist, Camper, first tried to gauge the intelligence levels of different animals and human races by measuring the facial angle, some theorists boldly claimed that certain apes were just as similar to the more primitive human races as those races are to humans in general. They suggested that a scale could be drawn from "apes with very low foreheads" to the African human variety, and from there to Europeans. The facial angle was calculated by drawing a line from the prominent center of the forehead to the most forward part of the lower jawbone and measuring the angle it created with the horizontal line; it was stated that there was a consistent series of such angles stretching from birds to mammals.

The gradation from the dog to the monkey was said to be perfect, and from that again to man. One of the ape tribe has a facial angle of 42°; and another, which approximated nearest to man in figure, an angle of 50°. To this succeeds (longo sed proximus intervallo) the head of the African negro, which, as well as that of the Calmuck, forms an angle of 70°; while that of the European contains 80°. The Roman painters preferred the angle of 95°; and the character of beauty and sublimity so striking in some works of Grecian sculpture, as in the head of the Apollo, and in the Medusa of Sisocles, is given by an angle which amounts to 100°.836

The transition from dog to monkey was considered seamless, and then from monkey to human. One type of ape has a facial angle of 42°, and another, which looks most like a human, has an angle of 50°. Following that (with a long but close gap) is the head of the African individual, which, like that of the Calmuck, has an angle of 70°, while the European's angle is 80°. Roman painters favored an angle of 95°, and the beauty and grandeur evident in some Grecian sculptures, such as the head of Apollo and the Medusa by Sisocles, are characterized by an angle of 100°. 836

A great number of valuable facts and curious analogies in comparative anatomy were brought to light during the investigations which were made by Camper, John Hunter, and others, to illustrate this scale of organization; and their facts and generalizations must not be confounded with the fanciful systems which White and others deduced from them.837

A lot of valuable facts and interesting comparisons in comparative anatomy were revealed during the research done by Camper, John Hunter, and others to explain this scale of organization; and their facts and conclusions should not be mixed up with the imaginative systems that White and others derived from them.837

That there is some connexion between an elevated and capacious forehead, in certain races of men, and a large developement of the intellectual faculties, seems highly probable; and that a low facial angle is frequently accompanied with inferiority of mental powers, is certain; but the attempt to trace a gradual scale of intelligence through the different species of animals accompanying the modifications of the form of the scull, is a mere visionary speculation. It has been found necessary to 609 exaggerate the sagacity of the ape tribe at the expense of the dog; and strange contradictions have arisen in the conclusions deduced from the structure of the elephant; some anatomists being disposed to deny the quadruped the intelligence which he really possesses, because they found that the volume of his brain was small in comparison to that of the other mammalia; while others were inclined to magnify extravagantly the superiority of his intellect, because the vertical height of his skull is so great when compared to its horizontal length.

There seems to be a connection between having a high and broad forehead in certain human races and increased intellectual ability, and it's definitely true that a low facial angle often goes along with lower mental capacity. However, trying to establish a clear hierarchy of intelligence across different animal species based on changes in skull shape is just wishful thinking. It has been necessary to exaggerate the intelligence of apes at the expense of dogs, and strange contradictions have come up in conclusions drawn from the structure of elephants; some anatomists tend to overlook the intelligence that elephants do have because they see their brain volume as small compared to other mammals, while others go too far in claiming their intelligence is superior because the vertical height of their skull is so large in comparison to its horizontal length.

Different races of men are all of one species.—It would be irrelevant to our subject if we were to enter into a farther discussion on these topics; because, even if a graduated scale of organization and intelligence could have been established, it would prove nothing in favor of a tendency, in each species, to attain a higher state of perfection. I may refer the reader to the writings of Blumenbach, Prichard, Lawrence, and more recently Latham838, for convincing proofs that the varieties of form, color, and organization of different races of men, are perfectly consistent with the generally received opinion, that all the individuals of the species have originated from a single pair; and, while they exhibit in man as many diversities of a physiological nature as appear in any other species, they confirm also the opinion of the slight deviation from a common standard of which species are capable.

Different races of humans are all part of the same species.—It would be irrelevant to our topic if we went into more detail on these subjects; because, even if we could establish a graduated scale of organization and intelligence, it wouldn’t support the idea that each species is trending toward a higher state of perfection. I can point the reader to the writings of Blumenbach, Prichard, Lawrence, and more recently Latham838, for compelling evidence that the variations in form, color, and organization among different races of humans are completely consistent with the widely accepted belief that all individuals of the species come from a single pair; and while they show as much physiological diversity in humans as in any other species, they also support the idea of the slight variation from a common standard that different species can achieve.

The power of existing and multiplying in every latitude, and in every variety of situation and climate, which has enabled the great human family to extend itself over the habitable globe, is partly, says Lawrence, the result of physical constitution, and partly of the mental prerogative of man. If he did not possess the most enduring and flexible corporeal frame, his arts would not enable him to be the inhabitant of all climates, and to brave the extremes of heat and cold, and the other destructive influences of local situation.839 Yet, notwithstanding this flexibility of bodily frame, we find no signs of indefinite departure from a common standard, and the intermarriages of individuals of the most remote varieties are not less fruitful than between those of the same tribe.

The ability to exist and thrive in every part of the world, regardless of different settings and climates, has allowed humanity to spread across the livable planet. According to Lawrence, this is partly due to our physical makeup and partly because of our unique mental capabilities. If humans didn't have such a resilient and adaptable body, our skills wouldn't allow us to live in all climates or withstand extreme heat and cold, as well as other harmful environmental factors.839 However, despite this adaptability, we see no signs of a significant deviation from a common standard, and the offspring produced from intermarriages between individuals from the most distant varieties are just as viable as those from the same group.

Tiedemann on the brain of the fœtus in vertebrated animals.—There is yet another department of anatomical discovery to which I must allude, because it has appeared to some persons to afford a distant analogy, at least, to that progressive development by which some of the inferior species may have been gradually perfected into those of more complex organization. Tiedemann found, and his discoveries have been most fully confirmed and elucidated by M. Serres, that the brain of the fœtus, in the highest class of vertebrated animals, assumes, in succession, forms, bearing a certain degree of resemblance to those which belong to fishes, reptiles, and birds, before it acquires the additions and modifications which are peculiar to the mammiferous tribe; so that, in the passage from the embryo to the perfect mammifer, there is a typical representation, 610 it is said, of all those transformations which the primitive species are supposed to have undergone, during a long series of generations, between the present period and the remotest geological era.

Tiedemann on the brain of the fetus in vertebrate animals.—There's another area of anatomical discovery I need to mention because some people see a distant analogy, at least, to the gradual development through which some of the simpler species may have evolved into those with more complex structures. Tiedemann discovered, and his findings have been thoroughly confirmed and explained by M. Serres, that the brain of the fetus in the highest class of vertebrates takes on forms in succession that bear some resemblance to those found in fish, reptiles, and birds, before it develops the features unique to mammals. So, in the transition from the embryo to the fully developed mammal, there is a typical representation, 610 it is said, of all the transformations that primitive species are believed to have gone through over a long series of generations from the present time back to the earliest geological era.

"If you examine the brain of the mammalia," says M. Serres, "at an early stage of uterine life, you perceive the cerebral hemispheres consolidated, as in fish, in two vesicles, isolated one from the other; at a later period, you see them affect the configuration of the cerebral hemispheres of reptiles; still later again, they present you with the forms of those of birds; finally they acquire, at the era of birth, and sometimes later, the permanent forms which the adult mammalia present.

"If you look at the brain of mammals," says M. Serres, "at an early stage of development in the womb, you can see that the cerebral hemispheres are formed into two separate vesicles, just like in fish. As time goes on, they start to resemble the shape of the cerebral hemispheres in reptiles; even later, they take on the forms seen in birds. Finally, at birth, and sometimes even after, they develop into the permanent shapes that adult mammals have."

"The cerebral hemispheres, then, arrive at the state which we observe in the higher animals only by a series of successive metamorphoses. If we reduce the whole of these evolutions to four periods, we shall see, that in the first are born the cerebral lobes of fishes; and this takes place homogeneously in all classes. The second period will give us the organization of reptiles; the third, the brain of birds; and the fourth, the complex hemispheres of mammalia.

"The cerebral hemispheres evolve into the state we see in higher animals through a series of transformations. If we break down these changes into four stages, we find that the first stage produces the cerebral lobes of fish, occurring uniformly across all classes. The second stage gives us the structure of reptiles, the third results in the brains of birds, and the fourth leads to the complex hemispheres found in mammals."

"If we could develop the different parts of the brain of the inferior classes, we should make, in succession, a reptile out of a fish, a bird out of a reptile, and a mammiferous quadruped out of a bird. If, on the contrary, we could starve this organ in the mammalia, we might reduce it successively to the condition of the brain of the three inferior classes.

"If we could enhance the various parts of the brain in lower classes, we would transform a fish into a reptile, a reptile into a bird, and a bird into a mammal. Conversely, if we could deprive this organ in mammals, we could gradually reduce it to the state of the brain found in the three lower classes."

"Nature often presents us with this last phenomenon in monsters, but never exhibits the first. Among the various deformities which organized beings may experience, they never pass the limits of their own classes to put on the forms of the class above them. Never does a fish elevate itself so as to assume the form of the brain of a reptile; nor does the latter ever attain that of birds; nor the bird that of the mammifer. It may happen that a monster may have two heads; but the conformation of the brain always remains circumscribed narrowly within the limits of its class."840

"Nature often shows us this final phenomenon in monsters, but never displays the first. Among the different deformities that living beings can have, they never go beyond the limits of their own classes to take on the forms of the class above them. A fish never evolves to take on the brain structure of a reptile; nor does a reptile ever reach the form of a bird; nor does a bird achieve that of a mammal. A monster might have two heads, but the structure of the brain always stays strictly within the boundaries of its class."840

Dr. Clark of Cambridge, in a memoir on "Fœtal Development" (1845), has shown that the concurrent labours of Valentin, Ratké, and Bischoff disprove the reality of the supposed anatomical analogy between the embryo condition of certain organs in the higher orders, and the perfect structure of the same organs in animals of an inferior class. The hearts and brains, for example, of birds and mammals do not pass through forms which are permanent in fishes and reptiles; there is only just so much resemblance as may point to a unity of plan running through the organization of the whole series of vertebrated animals; but which lends no support whatever to the notion of a gradual transmutation of one species into another; least of all of the passage, in the course of many generations, from an animal of a more simple to one of a more complex structure.

Dr. Clark from Cambridge, in a paper on "Fetal Development" (1845), has demonstrated that the combined work of Valentin, Ratké, and Bischoff disproves the alleged anatomical similarity between the embryonic stages of certain organs in higher animals and the fully developed structure of those organs in lower animals. For instance, the hearts and brains of birds and mammals do not go through permanent forms like those in fish and reptiles; there is only a slight resemblance that suggests a common design throughout all vertebrates, but this does not support the idea of gradual change from one species to another; especially not the transition over many generations from a simpler animal to a more complex one.

611 Recapitulation.—For the reasons, therefore, detailed in this and the two preceding chapters, we may draw the following inferences in regard to the reality of species in nature:—

611 Summary.—Based on the reasons discussed in this and the previous two chapters, we can make the following conclusions about the reality of species in nature:—

1st. That there is a capacity in all species to accommodate themselves, to a certain extent, to a change of external circumstances, this extent varying greatly, according to the species.

1st. That all species have the ability to adjust themselves to some degree to changes in their external circumstances, with the level of adaptability varying greatly depending on the species.

2ndly. When the change of situation which they can endure is great, it is usually attended by some modifications of the form, colour, size, structure, or other particulars; but the mutations thus superinduced are governed by constant laws, and the capability of so varying, forms part of the permanent specific character.

2ndly. When the change in their situation that they can handle is significant, it usually comes with some changes in form, color, size, structure, or other details; however, the changes that occur are governed by consistent laws, and the ability to adapt in this way is part of their permanent specific character.

3dly. Some acquired peculiarities, of form, structure, and instinct, are transmissible to the offspring; but these consist of such qualities and attributes only as are intimately related to the natural wants and propensities of the species.

3rdly. Some unique traits in form, structure, and instinct can be passed down to offspring; however, these only include qualities and characteristics that are closely connected to the natural needs and tendencies of the species.

4thly. The entire variation from the original type, which any given kind of change can produce, may usually be effected in a brief period of time, after which no farther deviation can be obtained by continuing to alter the circumstances, though ever so gradually; indefinite divergence, either in the way of improvement or deterioration, being prevented, and the least possible excess beyond the defined limits being fatal to the existence of the individual.

4thly. The complete variation from the original type that any specific change can create usually happens in a short amount of time, after which no further differences can be achieved by continuing to change the circumstances, no matter how slowly; indefinite divergence, whether in the form of improvement or decline, is blocked, and any significant excess beyond the defined limits is detrimental to the survival of the individual.

5thly. The intermixture of distinct species is guarded against by the aversion of the individuals composing them to sexual union, or by the sterility of the mule offspring. It does not appear that true hybrid races have ever been perpetuated for several generations, even by the assistance of man; for the cases usually cited relate to the crossing of mules with individuals of pure species, and not to the intermixture of hybrid with hybrid.

5thly. The mixing of different species is prevented by the individuals’ reluctance to mate with each other, or by the infertility of mule offspring. It seems that true hybrid races have never been sustained for multiple generations, even with human intervention; the examples often mentioned involve breeding mules with pure species, not the mixing of hybrid with hybrid.

6thly. From the above considerations, it appears that species have a real existence in nature; and that each was endowed, at the time of its creation, with the attributes and organization by which it is now distinguished.

6thly. Based on the points mentioned above, it seems that species truly exist in nature, and each was given, at the time of its creation, the characteristics and structure that define it today.


CHAPTER XXXVII.

LAWS WHICH REGULATE THE GEOGRAPHICAL DISTRIBUTION OF SPECIES.

Analogy of climate not attended with identity of species—Botanical geography—Stations—Habitations—Distinct provinces of indigenous plants—Vegetation of islands—Marine vegetation—In what manner plants become diffused—Effects of wind, rivers, marine currents—Agency of animals—Many seeds pass through the stomachs of animals and birds undigested—Agency of man in the dispersion of plants, both voluntary and involuntary—Its analogy to that of the inferior animals.

Analogy of climate not attended with identity of species—Botanical geography—Stations—Habitations—Distinct provinces of native plants—Vegetation of islands—Marine vegetation—How plants spread—Effects of wind, rivers, and ocean currents—Role of animals—Many seeds pass through the stomachs of animals and birds undigested—Role of humans in the spread of plants, both intentional and unintentional—Its similarity to that of lower animals.

Next to determining the question whether species have a real existence, the consideration of the laws which regulate their geographical distribution is a subject of primary importance to the geologist. It is only by studying these laws with attention, by observing the positions which groups of species occupy at present, and inquiring how these may be varied in the course of time by migrations, by changes in physical geography, and other causes, that we can hope to learn whether the duration of species be limited, or in what manner the state of the animate world is affected by the endless vicissitudes of the inanimate.

Next to figuring out whether species truly exist, understanding the laws that govern their geographical distribution is extremely important for geologists. We can only hope to learn if the duration of species is limited, or how the living world is impacted by the constant changes in the non-living world, by closely studying these laws, observing the current positions of species groups, and examining how these may shift over time due to migrations, changes in physical geography, and other factors.

Different regions inhabited by distinct species.—That different regions of the globe are inhabited by entirely distinct animals and plants, is a fact which has been familiar to all naturalists since Buffon first pointed out the want of specific identity between the land quadrupeds of America and those of the Old World. The same phenomenon has, in later times, been forced in a striking manner upon our attention, by the examination of New Holland, where the indigenous species of animals and plants were found to be, almost without exception, distinct from those known in other parts of the world.

Different regions inhabited by distinct species.—The fact that different regions of the world are home to completely different animals and plants has been well-known to all naturalists since Buffon first highlighted the lack of specific identity between the land mammals of America and those from the Old World. More recently, this phenomenon has drawn our attention in a striking way through the study of New Holland, where the native species of animals and plants were found to be, almost without exception, different from those recognized in other areas of the world.

But the extent of this parcelling out of the globe amongst different nations, as they have been termed, of plants and animals—the universality of a phenomenon so extraordinary and unexpected, may be considered as one of the most interesting facts clearly established by the advance of modern science.

But the extent of this distribution of the world among different nations, as they are called, of plants and animals—the widespread occurrence of such an extraordinary and unexpected phenomenon—can be seen as one of the most fascinating facts firmly established by the progress of modern science.

Scarcely fourteen hundred species of plants appear to have been known and described by the Greeks, Romans, and Arabians. At present, more than three thousand species are enumerated, as natives of our own island.841 In other parts of the world there have been now collected (1846) upwards of 100,000 species, specimens of which are preserved in European herbariums. It was not to be supposed, therefore, that the ancients should have acquired any correct notions respecting what may be called the geography of plants, although the influence of climate on the character of the vegetation could hardly have escaped their observation.

Scarcely fourteen hundred plant species were known and described by the Greeks, Romans, and Arabians. Today, more than three thousand species are listed as native to our island.841 In other parts of the world, over 100,000 species have been collected (1846), with specimens preserved in European herbariums. It’s unlikely that the ancients had accurate ideas about what we might call the geography of plants, although they probably noticed the influence of climate on vegetation.

613 Antecedently to investigation, there was no reason for presuming that the vegetable productions, growing wild in the eastern hemisphere, should be unlike those of the western, in the same latitude; nor that the plants of the Cape of Good Hope should be unlike those of the south of Europe; situations where the climate is little dissimilar. The contrary supposition would have seemed more probable, and we might have anticipated an almost perfect identity in the animals and plants which inhabit corresponding parallels of latitude. The discovery, therefore, that each separate region of the globe, both of the land and water, is occupied by distinct groups of species, and that most of the exceptions to this general rule may be referred to disseminating causes now in operation, is eminently calculated to excite curiosity, and to stimulate us to seek some hypothesis respecting the first introduction of species which may be reconcileable with such phenomena.

613 Before the investigation, there was no reason to believe that the plants found in the eastern hemisphere would be different from those in the western hemisphere at the same latitude, or that the flora of the Cape of Good Hope would differ from that of southern Europe, where the climate is quite similar. In fact, it would have seemed more likely that we would find almost identical animals and plants in corresponding latitudes. Therefore, the discovery that each region of the globe, both on land and in water, is home to distinct groups of species—and that most exceptions to this general rule can be traced back to current dispersal processes—greatly piques our curiosity and encourages us to come up with a hypothesis about how species were initially introduced that could explain these phenomena.

Botanical geography.—A comparison of the plants of different regions of the globe affords results more to be depended upon in the present state of our knowledge than those relating to the animal kingdom, because the science of botany is more advanced, and probably comprehends a great proportion of the total number of the vegetable productions of the whole earth. Humboldt, in several eloquent passages of his Personal Narrative, was among the first to promulgate philosophical views on this subject. Every hemisphere, says this traveller, produces plants of different species; and it is not by the diversity of climates that we can attempt to explain why equinoctial Africa has no Laurinæ, and the New World no Heaths; why the Calceolariæ are found only in the southern hemisphere; why the birds of the continent of India glow with colors less splendid than the birds of the hot parts of America: finally, why the tiger is peculiar to Asia, and the ornithorhynchus to New Holland.842

Botanical geography.—Comparing the plants of different regions around the world gives us more reliable results in our current understanding than comparisons related to animals, because the science of botany is more developed and likely includes a large portion of all plant species on Earth. Humboldt, in several powerful sections of his Personal Narrative, was among the first to share philosophical ideas on this topic. Every hemisphere, this traveler notes, has different plant species; and we cannot simply use climate differences to explain why equatorial Africa lacks Laurinæ and why the New World has no Heaths; why Calceolariæ are only found in the southern hemisphere; why the birds of India have less vibrant colors compared to birds in warm parts of America; and finally, why the tiger is unique to Asia while the ornithorhynchus is found in New Holland.842

"We can conceive," he adds, "that a small number of the families of plants, for instance, the Musaceæ and the Palms, cannot belong to very cold regions, on account of their internal structure and the importance of certain organs; but we cannot explain why no one of the family of Melastomas vegetates north of the parallel of thirty degrees; or why no rose-tree belongs to the southern hemisphere. Analogy of climates is often found in the two continents without identity of productions."843

"We can imagine," he adds, "that a few plant families, like the Musaceae and the Palms, can't thrive in very cold areas because of their internal structure and the significance of certain organs; however, we can't understand why none of the Melastoma family grows north of the thirty-degree parallel, or why no rose bushes are found in the southern hemisphere. Similar climates are often present in both continents without matching types of plants." 843

The luminous essay of De Candolle on "Botanical Geography" presents us with the fruits of his own researches and those of Humboldt, Brown, and other eminent botanists, so arranged, that the principal phenomena of the distribution of plants are exhibited in connexion with the causes to which they are chiefly referrible.844 "It might not, perhaps, be difficult," observes this writer, "to find two points, in the United States and in Europe, or in Equinoctial America and Africa, which present all the same circumstances: as, for example, the same temperature, 614 the same height above the sea, a similar soil, an equal dose of humidity; yet nearly all, perhaps all, the plants in these two similar localities shall be distinct. A certain degree of analogy, indeed, of aspect, and even of structure, might very possibly be discoverable between the plants of the two localities in question; but the species would in general be different. Circumstances, therefore, different from those which now determine the stations, have had an influence on the habitations of plants."

The insightful essay by De Candolle on "Botanical Geography" shares the findings of his own research along with those of Humboldt, Brown, and other distinguished botanists, arranged in a way that highlights the main phenomena related to how plants are distributed in connection with the causes that primarily explain them.844 "It might not be too hard," this writer notes, "to identify two locations, one in the United States and another in Europe, or one in Equatorial America and another in Africa, that have all the same conditions: for instance, the same temperature, the same altitude, a similar type of soil, and the same level of humidity; yet almost all, if not all, of the plants in these two similar areas will be different. There may indeed be some similarities in appearance and even structure between the plants from the two areas, but the species would generally be distinct. Therefore, conditions that differ from those currently influencing the stations have affected the habitats of plants."

Stations and habitations of plants.—As I shall frequently have occasion to speak of the stations and habitations of plants in the technical sense in which the terms are used in the above passage, I may remind the geologist that station indicates the peculiar nature of the locality where each species is accustomed to grow, and has reference to climate, soil, humidity, light, elevation above the sea, and other analogous circumstances; whereas, by habitation is meant a general indication of the country where a plant grows wild. Thus the station of a plant may be a salt-marsh, a hill-side, the bed of the sea, or a stagnant pool. Its habitation may be Europe, North America, or New Holland, between the tropics. The study of stations has been styled the topography, that of habitations the geography, of botany. The terms thus defined, express each a distinct class of ideas, which have been often confounded together, and which are equally applicable in zoology.

Stations and habitats of plants.—As I will often refer to the stations and habitats of plants in the technical sense used in the passage above, I want to remind geologists that a station refers to the specific characteristics of the location where each species typically grows, and considers factors like climate, soil, moisture, light, altitude above sea level, and other similar conditions; while habitation refers to a general indication of the region where a plant grows in the wild. For example, a plant’s station could be a salt marsh, a hillside, the sea floor, or a stagnant pond. Its habitat could be Europe, North America, or New Zealand, among the tropics. The study of stations is referred to as the topography, while the study of habitats is called the geography of botany. The terms defined here express distinct classes of ideas that have often been confused and are equally relevant in zoology.

In farther illustration of the principle above alluded to, that difference of longitude, independently of any influence of temperature, is accompanied by a great, and sometimes a complete, diversity in the species of plants, De Candolle observes, that, out of 2891 species of phænogamous plants described by Pursh, in the United States, there are only 385 which are found in northern or temperate Europe. MM. Humboldt and Bonpland, in all their travels through equinoctial America, found only twenty-four species (these being all Cyperaceæ and Gramineæ) common to America and any part of the Old World. They collected, it is true, chiefly on the mountains, or the proportion would have been larger; for Dr. J. Hooker informs me that many tropical plants of the New World are identical with African species. Nevertheless, the general discordance of these Floras is very striking. On comparing New Holland with Europe, Mr. Brown ascertained that, out of 4100 species, discovered in Australia, there were only 166 common to Europe, and of this small number there were some few which may have been transported thither by man. Almost all of the 166 species were cryptogamic, and the rest consist, in nearly every case, of phænogamous plants which also inhabit intervening regions.

To further illustrate the principle mentioned earlier, that differences in longitude, regardless of temperature effects, lead to significant, and sometimes total, diversity in plant species, De Candolle points out that out of 2,891 species of flowering plants documented by Pursh in the United States, only 385 are found in northern or temperate Europe. Humboldt and Bonpland, during their travels through equatorial America, discovered only twenty-four species (all belonging to the Cyperaceae and Poaceae families) that are common to both America and any part of the Old World. It's true that they mostly collected on the mountains, or the proportion would have been higher; Dr. J. Hooker has informed me that many tropical plants from the New World are identical to African species. Still, the overall difference between these floras is quite striking. When comparing Australia with Europe, Mr. Brown found that out of 4,100 species identified in Australia, only 166 were common to Europe, and of this small number, a few may have been introduced by humans. Almost all of the 166 species were non-flowering plants, and the remainder mostly included flowering plants that also grow in the regions in between.

But what is still more remarkable, in the more widely separated parts of the ancient continent, notwithstanding the existence of an uninterrupted land-communication, the diversity in the specific character of the respective vegetations is almost as striking. Thus there is found one assemblage of species in China, another in the countries bordering the Black Sea and the Caspian, a third in those surrounding the Mediterranean, 615 a fourth in the great platforms of Siberia and Tartary, and so forth.

But what's even more remarkable is that in the more distant areas of the ancient continent, despite having continuous land connections, the differences in the specific types of vegetation are almost as striking. For example, there's one group of species in China, another in the countries around the Black Sea and the Caspian Sea, a third in those surrounding the Mediterranean, 615 a fourth in the vast regions of Siberia and Tartary, and so on.

The distinctness of the groups of indigenous plants, in the same parallel of latitude, is greatest where continents are disjoined by a wide expanse of ocean. In the northern hemisphere, near the pole, where the extremities of Europe, Asia, and America unite or approach near to one another, a considerable number of the same species of plants are found, common to the three continents. But it has been remarked, that these plants, which are thus so widely diffused in the arctic regions, are also found in the chain of the Aleutian islands, which stretch almost across from America to Asia, and which may probably have served as the channel of communication for the partial blending of the Floras of the adjoining regions. It has, indeed, been observed to be a general rule, that plants found at two points very remote from each other occur also in places intermediate.

The differences between groups of native plants at the same latitude are most pronounced where continents are separated by a large ocean. In the northern hemisphere, close to the pole, where the ends of Europe, Asia, and America come together or are near each other, many of the same plant species can be found across all three continents. However, it's been noted that these plants, which are so widespread in the Arctic regions, are also present in the Aleutian Islands, which stretch almost all the way from America to Asia, likely serving as a pathway for the partial mixing of the plant life from the neighboring areas. In fact, it's generally observed that plants found in two distant locations also appear in the areas in between.

Dr. J. Hooker informs me that in high latitudes in the southern ocean, in spite of the great extent of the sea, Floras of widely disconnected islands contain many species in common. Perhaps icebergs, transporting to vast distances not only stones, but soil with the seeds of plants, may explain this unusually wide diffusion of insular plants.

Dr. J. Hooker tells me that in the high latitudes of the southern ocean, despite the large area of the sea, the flora of many distant islands has many species in common. It’s possible that icebergs, carrying not just rocks but also soil with plant seeds over long distances, could explain this unusually widespread distribution of island plants.

In islands very distant from continents the total number of plants is comparatively small; but a large proportion of the species are such as occur nowhere else. In so far as the Flora of such islands is not peculiar to them, it contains, in general, species common to the nearest main lands.845 The islands of the great southern ocean exemplify these rules; the easternmost containing more American, and the western more Indian plants.846 Madeira and Teneriffe contain many species, and even entire genera, peculiar to them; but they have also plants in common with Portugal, Spain, the Azores, and the north-west coast of Africa.847

In islands that are far from continents, the total number of plants is relatively small; however, a large portion of the species are unique to those islands. When the flora of such islands isn't unique, it generally includes species that are common to the closest mainland areas.845 The islands in the southern ocean illustrate these patterns; the easternmost islands have more American plants, while the western ones have more Indian plants.846 Madeira and Teneriffe have many species, and even entire genera, that are unique to them; but they also share plants with Portugal, Spain, the Azores, and the north-west coast of Africa.847

In the Canaries, out of 533 species of phænogamous plants, it is said that 310 are peculiar to these islands, and the rest identical with those of the African continent; but in the Flora of St. Helena, which is so far distant even from the western shores of Africa, there have been found, out of thirty native species of the phænogamous class, only one or two which are to be found in any other part of the globe. On the other hand, of sixty cryptogamic plants, collected by Dr. J. Hooker in the same island, twelve only were peculiar.

In the Canaries, out of 533 species of flowering plants, it’s said that 310 are unique to these islands, while the rest are the same as those on the African continent. However, in the Flora of St. Helena, which is quite far from the western shores of Africa, there have been found, out of thirty native species of flowering plants, only one or two that are found anywhere else in the world. On the other hand, of sixty non-flowering plants collected by Dr. J. Hooker on the same island, only twelve were unique.

The natural history of the Galapagos archipelago, described by Mr. Darwin, affords another very instructive illustration of the laws governing the geographical distribution of plants and animals in islands. This group consists of ten principal islands, situated in the Pacific Ocean, under the equator, about 600 miles westward of the coast of South America. As they are all formed of volcanic rocks, many of the craters, of which there are about 2000 in number, having a very fresh aspect, we may 616 regard the whole as much more modern in origin than the mass of the adjoining continent; yet neither has the Flora nor Fauna been derived from South America, but consist of species for the most part indigenous, yet stamped with a character decidedly South American.

The natural history of the Galapagos archipelago, as described by Mr. Darwin, provides a compelling example of the rules that dictate how plants and animals are distributed geographically on islands. This group includes ten main islands located in the Pacific Ocean, right on the equator, about 600 miles west of the South American coast. Since they are all made of volcanic rock, and with around 2000 craters that appear quite fresh, we can consider the islands to be much younger in origin than the surrounding continent. However, neither the flora nor fauna originated from South America; instead, they consist mostly of native species that still carry a distinctly South American character.

What is still more singular, there is a difference between the species inhabiting the different islands. Of flowering plants, for example, there are 185 species at present known, and forty cryptogamic, making together 225. One hundred of the former class are new species, probably confined to this archipelago; and of the rest, ten at least have been introduced by man. Of twenty-one species of Compositæ, all but one are peculiar, and they belong to twelve genera, no less than ten of which genera are confined to the Galapagos. Dr. Hooker observes, that the type of this Flora has an undoubted relation to that of the western side of South America, and he detects in it no affinity with that of the numerous islands scattered over other parts of the Pacific. So in regard to the birds, reptiles, land-shells, and insects, this archipelago, standing as it does in the Pacific Ocean, is zoologically part of America. Although each small island is not more than fifty or sixty miles apart, and most of them are in sight of each other, formed of precisely the same rocks, rising nearly to an equal height, and placed under a similar climate, they are tenanted each by a different set of beings, the tortoises, mocking-thrushes, finches, beetles, scarcely any of them ever ranging over the whole, and often not even common to any two of the islands.

What’s even more unique is that there are differences among the species living on the various islands. For instance, there are currently 185 known species of flowering plants and forty species of cryptogams, totaling 225. One hundred of the flowering plant species are likely new and specific to this archipelago, while at least ten of the others have been introduced by humans. Out of twenty-one species of Compositæ, only one is not unique, and they belong to twelve genera, with ten of those genera being exclusive to the Galapagos. Dr. Hooker points out that the type of flora found here is closely related to that of the western coast of South America, and there is no connection to the flora of the many islands scattered across other parts of the Pacific. The same applies to the birds, reptiles, land snails, and insects; this archipelago, located in the Pacific Ocean, is zoologically part of America. Even though each small island is only about fifty or sixty miles apart, with most of them visible from one another, made up of the same types of rocks, rising to similar heights, and experiencing the same climate, each island is home to a different set of species. The tortoises, mockingbirds, finches, and beetles hardly ever range across the whole archipelago and often aren’t even shared between any two islands.

"The archipelago," says Mr. Darwin, "is a little world within itself, or rather a satellite attached to America; whence it has derived a few stray colonists, and has received the general character of its indigenous productions. One is astonished," he adds, "at the amount of creative force displayed on so many small, barren, and rocky islands, and still more so, at its diverse, yet analogous action on points so near each other. I have said that the Galapagos archipelago might be called a satellite attached to America, but it should rather be called a group of satellites physically similar, organically distinct, yet intimately related to each other, and all related in a marked, though much lesser degree, to the great American continent."848

"The archipelago," Mr. Darwin says, "is like a small world on its own, or more accurately, a satellite connected to America; from which it has gotten a few random settlers and has taken on the general traits of its native species. One is amazed," he adds, "at the level of creative energy shown on so many small, barren, and rocky islands, and even more so, at its varied yet similar effects on places that are so close together. I mentioned that the Galapagos archipelago could be considered a satellite linked to America, but it would be more accurate to see it as a group of satellites that are physically alike, organically distinct, yet closely related to each other, and all connected, though to a much lesser extent, to the vast American continent." 848

Number of botanical provinces.—De Candolle has enumerated twenty great botanical provinces inhabited by indigenous or aboriginal plants; and although many of these contain a variety of species which are common to several others, and sometimes to places very remote, yet the lines of demarcation are, upon the whole, astonishingly well defined.849 Nor is it likely that the bearing of the evidence on which these general views are founded will ever be materially affected, since they are already confirmed by the examination of nearly one hundred thousand species of plants.

Number of botanical provinces.—De Candolle has listed twenty major botanical provinces that are home to native or indigenous plants. While many of these provinces include species that are also found in several others, and sometimes even in very distant locations, the boundaries are, overall, surprisingly clear.849 It's unlikely that the evidence supporting these general conclusions will significantly change, as they are already backed by the study of nearly one hundred thousand plant species.

617 The entire change of opinion which the contemplation of those phenomena has brought about is worthy of remark. The first travellers were persuaded that they should find, in distant regions, the plants of their own country, and they took a pleasure in giving them the same names. It was some time before this illusion was dissipated; but so fully sensible did botanists at last become of the extreme smallness of the number of phænogamous plants common to different continents, that the ancient Floras fell into disrepute. All grew diffident of the pretended identifications; and we now find that every naturalist is inclined to examine each supposed exception with scrupulous severity.850 If they admit the fact, they begin to speculate on the mode whereby the seeds may have been transported from one country into the other, or enquire on which of two continents the plant was indigenous, assuming that a species, like an individual, cannot have two birthplaces.

617 The complete shift in perspective that exploring these phenomena has caused is noteworthy. The first travelers believed they would discover the plants from their own country in far-off lands, and they enjoyed naming them the same way. It took a while for this misconception to fade away; however, botanists eventually became very aware of how few flowering plants are shared across different continents, leading to the old Floras being viewed with skepticism. Everyone became cautious about the supposed identifications; now, every naturalist tends to scrutinize each claimed exception closely. If they acknowledge the fact, they then start to theorize how the seeds might have traveled from one country to another, or they debate which of the two continents the plant originally came from, assuming that a species, like a person, can’t have two places of origin.

Marine vegetation.—The marine vegetation is divisible into different systems, like those prevailing on the land; but they are much fewer, as we might have expected, the temperature of the ocean being more uniform than that of the atmosphere, and consequently the dispersion of species from one zone to another being less frequently checked by the intervention of uncongenial climates. The proportion also of land to sea throughout the globe being small, the migration of marine plants is not so often stopped by barriers of land, as is that of the terrestrial species by the ocean. The number of hydrophytes, as they are termed, is very considerable, and their stations are found to be infinitely more varied than could have been anticipated; for while some plants are covered and uncovered daily by the tide, others live at the depth of several hundred feet. Among the known provinces of Algæ, we may mention, 1st, The north circumpolar, from lat 60° N. to the pole; 2dly, The North Atlantic or the region of Fucus proper and Delesseriæ, extending from lat. 40° N. to lat. 60° N.; 3dly, That of the Mediterranean, which may be regarded as a sub-region of the fourth or warmer temperate zone of the Atlantic, between lat. 23° N. and lat. 40° N.; 5thly, The Tropical Atlantic, in which Sargassum, Rhodomelia, Corallinea, and Siphonia abound; 6thly, The South Atlantic, where the Fucus reappears; 7thly, The Antarctic American, comprehending from Chili to Cape Horn, the Falkland Islands, and thence round the world south of latitude 50° S.; 8thly, The Australian and New Zealand, which is very peculiar, being characterized, among other generic forms, by Cystoseiriæ and Fuceæ; 9thly, The Indian Ocean and Red Sea; and, 10thly, The Chinese and Japanese seas.851 In addition to the above provinces, there are several others not yet well determined in the Pacific Ocean and elsewhere. There are, however, many species which range through several of these geographical regions of subaqueous vegetation, being common to very remote countries; as, for example, to the coasts of

Marine vegetation.—Marine vegetation can be divided into different systems, similar to those found on land. However, there are much fewer of them, as we would expect, because the ocean’s temperature is more consistent than that of the atmosphere. As a result, the spread of species from one zone to another is less often hindered by extreme climate changes. Additionally, since the ratio of land to sea around the globe is low, marine plants don’t face as many barriers from land as terrestrial species do from the ocean. The number of hydrophytes, as they are called, is quite large, and their habitats are found to be much more diverse than anticipated. Some plants are exposed and submerged daily by the tide, while others thrive at depths of several hundred feet. Among the known provinces of algae, we can list: 1st, The north circumpolar region, from latitude 60° N. to the pole; 2nd, The North Atlantic or the area of Fucus and Delesseriæ, stretching from latitude 40° N. to latitude 60° N.; 3rd, The Mediterranean region, considered a sub-region of the fourth or warmer temperate zone of the Atlantic, between latitude 23° N. and latitude 40° N.; 5th, The Tropical Atlantic, where Sargassum, Rhodomelia, Corallinea, and Siphonia are abundant; 6th, The South Atlantic, where Fucus reappears; 7th, The Antarctic American region, covering from Chile to Cape Horn, the Falkland Islands, and then circling the globe south of latitude 50° S.; 8th, The Australian and New Zealand region, which is very unique, characterized by forms like Cystoseiriæ and Fuceæ; 9th, The Indian Ocean and Red Sea; and 10th, The Chinese and Japanese seas.851 In addition to these provinces, there are many others in the Pacific Ocean and elsewhere that aren’t well defined yet. However, there are many species that span several of these geographic regions of underwater vegetation, being found in very distant locations; for example, along the coasts of

618 Europe and the United States, and others, to Cape Horn and Van Diemen's Land, the same plants extending also for the most part to the New Zealand sea. Of the species strictly antarctic (excluding the New Zealand and Tasmanian groups) Dr. Hooker has identified not less than a fifth part of the whole with British Algæ! Yet is there a much smaller proportion of cosmopolite species among the Algæ than among the terrestrial cellular plants, such as lichens, mosses, and Hepaticæ.

618 Europe, the United States, and others, up to Cape Horn and Van Diemen's Land, have similar plants that mostly reach the waters around New Zealand. Dr. Hooker has identified that at least one-fifth of the strictly Antarctic species (excluding the groups from New Zealand and Tasmania) are the same as British algae! However, there is a significantly smaller proportion of globally distributed species among algae compared to terrestrial cellular plants like lichens, mosses, and liverworts.

It must always be borne in mind, that the distinctness alluded to between the provinces, whether of subaqueous or terrestrial plants, relates strictly to species, and not to forms. In regard to the numerical preponderance of certain forms, and many peculiarities of internal structure, there is usually a marked agreement in the vegetable productions of districts placed in corresponding latitudes, and under similar physical circumstances, however remote their position. Thus there are innumerable points of analogy between the vegetation of the Brazils, equinoctial Africa, and India; and there are also points of difference wherein the plants of these regions are distinguishable from all extra-tropical groups. But there is a very small proportion of the entire number of species common to the three continents. The same may be said, if we compare the plants of the United States with that of the middle of Europe; the species are distinct, but the forms are often so analogous, as to have been styled "geographical representatives." There are very few species of phænogamous plants, says Dr. J. Hooker, common to Van Diemen's Land, New Zealand, and Fuegia, but a great many genera, and some of them are confined to those three distant regions of the southern hemisphere, being in many instances each severally represented by a single species. The same naturalist also observes that the southern temperate as well as the antarctic regions, possess each of them representatives of some of the genera of the analogous climates of the opposite hemisphere; but very few of the species are identical unless they be such as are equally diffused over other countries, or which inhabit the Andes, by the aid of which they have evidently effected their passage southwards.

It should always be kept in mind that the distinction mentioned between the provinces, whether for underwater or land plants, specifically pertains to species, not forms. Regarding the numerical dominance of certain forms and many unique internal structures, there is usually a notable similarity in the plant life of regions situated in corresponding latitudes and under similar physical conditions, no matter how far apart they are. For example, there are countless similarities between the vegetation of Brazil, equatorial Africa, and India; yet there are also differences that set the plants of these areas apart from all extra-tropical groups. However, there is a very small number of species that are common among the three continents. The same applies when comparing the plants of the United States with those of central Europe; the species are distinct, but the forms are often so similar that they have been called "geographical representatives." According to Dr. J. Hooker, there are very few species of flowering plants common to Tasmania, New Zealand, and Patagonia, but there are many genera, some of which are unique to those three distant regions of the southern hemisphere, often represented by a single species. The same naturalist also notes that the southern temperate and Antarctic regions each have representatives of some genera that are found in the analogous climates of the opposite hemisphere; however, very few species are identical unless they are widely distributed in other countries or found in the Andes, which have clearly facilitated their migration southward.

Manner in which plants become diffused.—Winds.—Let us now consider what means of diffusion, independently of the agency of man, are possessed by plants, whereby, in the course of ages, they may be enabled to stray from one of the botanical provinces above mentioned to another, and to establish new colonies at a great distance from their birthplace.

How plants spread.—Winds.—Now, let's look at how plants can spread without human help, allowing them over time to move from one botanical area to another and to form new colonies far from where they originated.

The principal of the inanimate agents provided by nature for scattering the seeds of plants over the globe, are the movements of the atmosphere and of the ocean, and the constant flow of water from the mountains to the sea. To begin with the winds: a great number of seeds, are furnished with downy and feathery appendages, enabling them, when ripe, to float in the air, and to be wafted easily to great distances by the most gentle breeze. Other plants are fitted for dispersion by means of an attached wing, as in the case of the fir tree, so that they are caught up by the wind as they fall from the cone, and are carried to a distance. Amongst the 619 comparatively small number of plants known to Linnæus, no less than 138 genera are enumerated as having winged seeds.

The main natural forces that help spread plant seeds around the world are the movements of the atmosphere, the ocean, and the constant flow of water from mountains to the sea. Starting with the winds: many seeds have soft, fluffy attachments that allow them to float in the air when they're ripe, so they can be easily carried off to great distances by a light breeze. Other plants are designed to disperse seeds through an attached wing, like fir trees, which get picked up by the wind as they fall from the cone and are transported away. Among the 619 relatively small number of plants identified by Linnæus, at least 138 genera are listed as having winged seeds.

As winds often prevail for days, weeks, or even months together, in the same direction, these means of transportation may sometimes be without limits; and even the heavier grains may be borne through considerable spaces, in a very short time, during ordinary tempests; for strong gales, which can sweep along grains of sand, often move at the rate of about forty miles an hour, and if the storm be very violent, at the rate of fifty-six miles.852 The hurricanes of tropical regions, which root up trees and throw down buildings, sweep along at the rate of ninety miles an hour; so that, for however short a time they prevail, they may carry even the heavier fruits and seeds over friths and seas of considerable width, and doubtless are often the means of introducing into islands the vegetation of adjoining continents. Whirlwinds are also instrumental in bearing along heavy vegetable substances to considerable distances. Slight ones may frequently be observed in our fields, in summer carrying up haycocks into the air, and then letting fall small tufts of hay far and wide over the country; but they are sometimes so powerful as to dry up lakes and ponds, and to break off the boughs of trees, and carry them up in a whirling column of air.

As winds can often blow in the same direction for days, weeks, or even months, these transportation methods can sometimes be limitless; even heavier grains can be carried over long distances in a very short time during typical storms. Strong winds, which can move grains of sand, often travel at about forty miles per hour, and in very severe storms, they can reach speeds of up to fifty-six miles per hour.852 Hurricanes in tropical regions, which can uproot trees and demolish buildings, can reach speeds of ninety miles per hour; therefore, no matter how briefly they last, they can transport even heavier fruits and seeds across wide bodies of water and are often responsible for introducing vegetation from nearby continents to islands. Whirlwinds can also move heavy plant material over significant distances. We often see lighter whirlwinds in our fields during summer, lifting hay bales into the air and scattering small tufts of hay across the land; however, they can sometimes be strong enough to dry up lakes and ponds, break off tree branches, and lift them in a swirling column of air.

Franklin tells us, in one of his letters, that he saw, in Maryland, a whirlwind which began by taking up the dust which lay in the road, in the form of a sugar loaf with the pointed end downwards, and soon after grew to the height of forty or fifty feet, being twenty or thirty in diameter. It advanced in a direction contrary to the wind; and although the rotary motion of the column was surprisingly rapid, its onward progress was sufficiently slow to allow a man to keep pace with it on foot. Franklin followed it on horseback, accompanied by his son, for three quarters of a mile, and saw it enter a wood, where it twisted and turned round large trees with surprising force. These were carried up in a spiral line, and were seen flying in the air, together with boughs and innumerable leaves, which, from their height, appeared reduced to the apparent size of flies. As this cause operates at different intervals of time throughout a great portion of the earth's surface, it may be the means of bearing not only plants but insects, land testacea and their eggs, with many other species of animals, to points which they could never otherwise have reached, and from which they may then begin to propagate themselves again as from a new centre.

Franklin mentions in one of his letters that he saw a whirlwind in Maryland that started by picking up dust from the road, forming a shape like an upside-down sugar loaf. It quickly grew to a height of forty or fifty feet, with a diameter of twenty or thirty feet. It moved in the opposite direction of the wind, and even though the column spun remarkably fast, it moved slowly enough for a person to keep up with it on foot. Franklin followed it on horseback, with his son, for about three-quarters of a mile until it entered a forest. There, it twisted and turned around large trees with amazing force. The trees were lifted in a spiral motion and seen flying through the air, along with branches and countless leaves that, from their height, looked as small as flies. Since this phenomenon occurs at different intervals across much of the earth, it can carry not just plants but also insects, land mollusks and their eggs, along with various other animal species to places they could never have reached otherwise. From those new locations, they might start to reproduce again as if from a new center.

Distribution of cryptogamous plants.—It has been found that a great numerical proportion of the exceptions to the limitation of species to certain quarters of the globe occur in the various tribes of cryptogamic plants. Linnæus observed that, as the germs of plants of this class, such as mosses, fungi, and lichens, consist of an impalpable powder, the particles of which are scarcely visible to the naked eye, there is no difficulty to account for their being dispersed throughout the atmosphere, and carried to every point of the globe, where there is a station fitted for them. 620 Lichens in particular ascend to great elevations, sometimes growing two thousand feet above the line of perpetual snow, at the utmost limits of vegetation, and where the mean temperature is nearly at the freezing point. This elevated position must contribute greatly to facilitate the dispersion of those buoyant particles of which their fructification consists.853

Distribution of cryptogamous plants.—It has been found that a significant number of the exceptions to the limitation of species to certain regions of the globe occur among various groups of cryptogamic plants. Linnæus noted that, since the spores of this class of plants, like mosses, fungi, and lichens, are made up of an extremely fine powder, with particles that are barely visible to the naked eye, it's easy to see how they can be spread throughout the atmosphere and carried to every corner of the globe where suitable conditions exist. 620 Lichens, in particular, can grow at high altitudes, sometimes reaching two thousand feet above the line of perpetual snow, at the very edge of vegetation, where the average temperature is nearly freezing. This high elevation likely helps greatly in spreading the buoyant particles that make up their reproductive structures.853

Some have inferred, from the springing up of mushrooms whenever particular soils and decomposed organic matter are mixed together, that the production of fungi is accidental, and not analogous to that of perfect plants. But Fries, whose authority on these questions is entitled to the highest respect, has shown the fallacy of this argument in favor of the old doctrine of equivocal generation. "The sporules of fungi," says this naturalist, "are so infinite, that in a single individual of Reticularia maxima, I have counted above ten millions, and so subtile as to be scarcely visible, often resembling thin smoke; so light that they may be raised perhaps by evaporation into the atmosphere, and dispersed in so many ways by the attraction of the sun, by insects, wind, elasticity, adhesion, &c., that it is difficult to conceive a place from which they may be excluded."854

Some people have suggested that the appearance of mushrooms when certain soils and decayed organic matter are combined is random, and not like how perfect plants grow. However, Fries, who is highly respected on these matters, has pointed out the flaws in this reasoning, supporting the traditional idea of spontaneous generation. "The spores of fungi," this naturalist states, "are so numerous that in a single specimen of Reticularia maxima, I've counted over ten million. They're so tiny that they're nearly invisible, often resembling thin smoke; so light that they might be lifted into the atmosphere, and distributed in countless ways by the sun's attraction, insects, wind, and other factors, making it hard to imagine a place where they can't reach." 854

The club-moss called Lycopodium cernuum affords a striking example of a cryptogamous plant universally distributed over all equinoctial countries. It scarcely ever passes beyond the northern tropic, except in one instance, where it appears around the hot-springs in the Azores, although it is neither an inhabitant of the Canaries nor Madeira. Doubtless its microscopic sporules are everywhere present, ready to germinate on any spot where they can enjoy throughout the year the proper quantity of warmth, moisture, light, and other conditions essential to the species.

The club-moss known as Lycopodium cernuum is a great example of a type of plant that can be found all over equatorial regions. It rarely goes beyond the northern tropic, except in one case where it grows near the hot springs in the Azores, even though it's not found in the Canaries or Madeira. Its microscopic spores are likely everywhere, just waiting to sprout in any place that has the right amount of warmth, moisture, light, and other conditions necessary for its growth throughout the year.

Almost every lichen brought home from the southern hemisphere by the antarctic expedition under Sir James Ross, amounting to no less than 200 species, was ascertained to be also an inhabitant of the northern hemisphere, and almost all of them European.

Almost every lichen brought back from the southern hemisphere by the Antarctic expedition led by Sir James Ross, totaling at least 200 species, was found to also exist in the northern hemisphere, and nearly all of them were European.

Agency of rivers and currents.—In considering, in the next place, the instrumentality of the aqueous agents of dispersion, I cannot do better than cite the words of one of our ablest botanical writers. "The mountain stream or torrent," observes Keith, "washes down to the valley the seeds which may accidentally fall into it, or which it may happen to sweep from its banks when it suddenly overflows them. The broad and majestic river, winding along the extensive plain, and traversing the continents of the world, conveys to the distance of many hundreds of miles the seeds that may have vegetated at its source. Thus the southern shores of the Baltic are visited by seeds which grew in the interior of Germany, and the western shores of the Atlantic by seeds that have been generated in the interior of America."855 Fruits, moreover, indigenous to America and the West Indies, such as that of the Mimosa scandens, the cashewnut and others, have been known to be drifted across the Atlantic 621 by the Gulf stream, on the western coasts of Europe, in such a state that they might have vegetated had the climate and soil been favourable. Among these the Guilandina Bonduc, a leguminous plant, is particularly mentioned, as having been raised from a seed found on the west coast of Ireland.856

Role of rivers and currents.—Next, when we look at how water acts as a means of distribution, I can't help but quote one of our leading botanical experts. "The mountain stream or torrent," Keith notes, "carries down to the valley the seeds that may accidentally fall into it or that it might sweep from its banks when it suddenly overflows. The wide and impressive river, meandering through the expansive plain and crossing the continents, transports seeds that may have sprouted at its source over many hundreds of miles. For instance, the southern shores of the Baltic receive seeds that grew in the interior of Germany, while the western shores of the Atlantic get seeds generated in the interior of America."855 Additionally, fruits native to America and the West Indies, like the Mimosa scandens, the cashew nut, and others, have been known to be carried across the Atlantic by the Gulf Stream to the western coasts of Europe in a condition suitable for growth if the climate and soil were favorable. Notably, the Guilandina Bonduc, a legume, has been specifically mentioned as having been grown from a seed found on the west coast of Ireland.856

Sir Hans Sloane states, that several kinds of beans cast ashore on the Orkney Isles, and Ireland, but none of which appear to have naturalized themselves, are derived from trees which grow in the West Indies, and many of them in Jamaica. He conjectures that they might have been conveyed by rivers into the sea, and then by the Gulf stream to greater distances, in the same manner as the sea-weed called Lenticula marina, or Sargasso, which grows on the rocks about Jamaica, is known to be "carried by the winds and current towards the coast of Florida, and thence into the North American ocean, where it lies very thick on the surface of the sea."857

Sir Hans Sloane notes that several types of beans have washed up on the Orkney Islands and in Ireland, but none seem to have established themselves there. These beans come from trees that grow in the West Indies, particularly in Jamaica. He speculates that they might have been transported by rivers into the sea and then carried by the Gulf Stream over long distances, similar to how the seaweed known as Lenticula marina, or Sargasso, which grows on the rocks around Jamaica, is carried by winds and currents toward the coast of Florida, and then into the North American ocean, where it collects in large quantities on the surface of the sea.857

The absence of liquid matter in the composition of seeds renders them comparatively insensible to heat and cold, so that they may be carried without detriment through climates where the plants themselves would instantly perish. Such is their power of resisting the effects of heat, that Spallanzani mentions some seeds that germinated after having been boiled in water.858 Sir John Herschel informs me that he has sown at the Cape of Good Hope the seeds of the Acacia lophanta after they had remained for twelve hours in water of 140° Fahrenheit, and they germinated far more rapidly than unboiled seeds. He also states that an eminent botanist, Baron Ludwig, could not get the seeds of a species of cedar to grow at the Cape till they were thoroughly boiled.

The lack of liquid in seeds makes them relatively unaffected by heat and cold, allowing them to be transported through climates where the plants would quickly die. Their ability to withstand heat is so strong that Spallanzani reported some seeds that sprouted after being boiled in water. 858 Sir John Herschel tells me that he planted the seeds of the Acacia lophanta at the Cape of Good Hope after they had soaked in water at 140° Fahrenheit for twelve hours, and they germinated much faster than unboiled seeds. He also mentions that a well-known botanist, Baron Ludwig, couldn't get the seeds of a cedar species to grow at the Cape until they had been completely boiled.

When therefore, a strong gale, after blowing violently off the land for a time, dies away, and the seeds alight upon the surface of the waters, or wherever the ocean, by eating away the sea-cliffs, throws down into its waves plants which would never otherwise reach the shores, the tides and currents become active instruments in assisting the dissemination of almost all classes of the vegetable kingdom. The pandanus and many other plants have been distributed in this way over the islands of the Pacific. I have before called attention (p. 618.) to the interesting fact that one-fifth of all the algæ found in the antarctic regions in 1841-3, by Dr. J. Hooker, were of species common to the British seas. He has suggested that cold currents which prevail from Cape Horn to the equator, and are there met by other cold water, may by their direct influence, as well as by their temperature, facilitate the passage of antarctic species to the Arctic Ocean. In like manner the migration of certain marine animals from the southern to the northern hemisphere may have been brought about by the same cause.

When a strong wind, after blowing hard off the coast for a while, calms down, the seeds land on the water's surface or wherever the ocean, by eroding the cliffs, drops plants that wouldn't typically reach the shore, the tides and currents help spread almost all types of plants. The pandanus and many other plants have been spread this way across the Pacific islands. I previously pointed out (p. 618.) the interesting fact that one-fifth of all the algae found in the Antarctic regions between 1841-3, by Dr. J. Hooker, were of species commonly found in British seas. He suggested that cold currents that flow from Cape Horn to the equator, meeting other cold water there, could directly influence, and also affect the temperature, making it easier for Antarctic species to move to the Arctic Ocean. Similarly, the migration of certain marine animals from the southern to the northern hemisphere may have happened for the same reason.

In a collection of six hundred plants from the neighborhood of the river Zaire, in Africa, Mr. Brown found that thirteen species were also 622 met with on the opposite shores of Guiana and Brazil. He remarked that most of these plants were found only on the lower parts of the river Zaire, and were chiefly such as produced seeds capable of retaining their vitality a long time in the currents of the ocean. Dr. J. Hooker informs me that after an examination of a great many insular floras, he has found that no one of the large natural orders is so rich in species common to other countries, as the Leguminosæ. The seeds in this order, which comprises the largest proportion of widely diffused littoral species, are better adapted than those of any other plants for water-carriage.

In a collection of six hundred plants from the area around the Zaire River in Africa, Mr. Brown discovered that thirteen species were also found on the opposite banks of Guiana and Brazil. He noted that most of these plants were located only in the lower parts of the Zaire River and mainly included those that produced seeds capable of surviving for a long time in ocean currents. Dr. J. Hooker tells me that after examining many island floras, he found that none of the major natural groups is as rich in species common to other regions as the Leguminosæ. The seeds in this group, which contains the largest number of widely distributed coastal species, are better suited than those of any other plants for being carried by water.

The migration of plants aided by islands.—Islands, moreover, and even the smallest rocks, play an important part in aiding such migrations; for when seeds alight upon them from the atmosphere, or are thrown up by the surf, they often vegetate, and supply the winds and waves with a repetition of new and uninjured crops of fruit and seeds. These may afterwards pursue their course through the atmosphere, or along the surface of the sea, in the same direction. The number of plants found at any given time on an islet affords us no test whatever of the extent to which it may have co-operated towards this end, since a variety of species may first thrive there and then perish, and be followed by other chance-comers like themselves. If neither St. Helena nor Ascension have promoted the botanical intercourse between the Old and New Worlds, we may easily account for the fact by remembering that they are not only extremely minute and isolated spots, but are also bounded by lofty and precipitous shores without beaches, where the seeds of foreign species could readily establish themselves.

The migration of plants aided by islands.—Islands, and even the smallest rocks, play a vital role in helping these migrations; when seeds land on them from the air or are washed up by the surf, they often grow and provide winds and waves with a consistent supply of fresh, unspoiled fruit and seeds. These can then continue their journey through the air or along the surface of the ocean in the same direction. The number of plants present at any given time on an islet doesn't tell us anything about how much it has contributed to this process since different species may thrive there temporarily before dying off, only to be replaced by other random arrivals. If neither St. Helena nor Ascension has facilitated the exchange of plants between the Old and New Worlds, we can easily explain this by noting that they are not only very small and isolated spots but also surrounded by high, steep shores without beaches, where seeds from foreign species could easily take root.

Currents and winds in the arctic regions drift along icebergs covered with an alluvial soil, on which herbs and pine-saplings are seen growing, which may often continue to vegetate on some distant shore where the ice-island is stranded.

Currents and winds in the Arctic drift along icebergs covered with sediment, where you can often see herbs and young pine trees growing. These plants can sometimes continue to thrive on a distant shore where the ice island has washed up.

Dispersion of marine plants.—With respect to marine vegetation, the seeds, being in their native element, may remain immersed in water without injury for indefinite periods, so that there is no difficulty in conceiving the diffusion of species wherever uncongenial climates, contrary currents, and other causes do not interfere. All are familiar with the sight of the floating sea-weed,

Dispersion of marine plants.—Regarding marine plants, the seeds, being in their natural environment, can stay submerged in water for unlimited time without damage, making it easy to imagine how species spread wherever unsuitable climates, opposing currents, and other factors don’t get in the way. Everyone is familiar with the sight of floating seaweed,

"Thrown from the rock on ocean's waves to sail, "Wherever the waves may crash, the storm's power holds strong."

Remarkable accumulations of that species of sea-weed generally known as gulf-weed, or sargasso, occur on each side of the equator in the Atlantic, Pacific, and Indian Oceans. Columbus and other navigators, who first encountered these banks of algæ in the Northern Atlantic, compared them to vast inundated meadows, and state that they retarded the progress of their vessels. The most extensive bank is a little west of the meridian of Fayal, one of the Azores, between latitudes 35° and 36°: violent north-winds sometimes prevail in this space, and drive the sea-weed to 623 low latitudes, as far as the 24th or even the 20th degree.859 Along the northern edge of the Gulf stream Dr. Hooker found Fucus nodosus, and F. serratus, which he traced all the way from lat. 36° N. to England.

Remarkable accumulations of a type of seaweed commonly known as gulf-weed or sargasso are found on both sides of the equator in the Atlantic, Pacific, and Indian Oceans. Columbus and other early navigators who first came across these banks of algae in the Northern Atlantic compared them to vast flooded meadows and noted that they slowed down the progress of their ships. The largest bank is located just west of the meridian of Fayal, one of the Azores, between latitudes 35° and 36°. Strong north winds often blow in this area, pushing the seaweed to lower latitudes, as far as the 24th or even the 20th degree. Along the northern edge of the Gulf Stream, Dr. Hooker found Fucus nodosus and F. serratus, which he traced all the way from lat. 36° N. to England.

The hollow pod-like receptacle in which the seeds of many algæ are lodged, and the filaments attached to the seed-vessels of others, seem intended to give buoyancy; and I may observe that these hydrophytes are in general proliferous, so that the smallest fragment of a branch can be developed into a perfect plant. The seeds, moreover, of the greater number of species are enveloped with a mucous matter like that which surrounds the eggs of some fish, and which not only protects them from injury, but serves to attach them to floating bodies or to rocks.

The hollow, pod-like container where the seeds of many algae are found, along with the filaments connected to the seed vessels of others, seems designed to provide buoyancy. It’s also worth noting that these water plants are generally proliferous, meaning even the smallest piece of a branch can grow into a complete plant. Furthermore, the seeds of most species are covered in a slimy substance similar to what surrounds the eggs of some fish, which not only protects them from damage but also helps them stick to floating objects or rocks.

Agency of animals in the distribution of plants.—But we have as yet considered part only of the fertile resources of nature for conveying seeds to a distance from their place of growth. The various tribes of animals are busily engaged in furthering an object whence they derive such important advantages. Sometimes an express provision is found in the structure of seeds to enable them to adhere firmly by prickles, hooks, and hairs, to the coats of animals, or feathers of the winged tribe, to which they remain attached for weeks, or even months, and are borne along into every region whither birds or quadrupeds may migrate. Linnæus enumerates fifty genera of plants, and the number now known to botanists is much greater, which are armed with hooks, by which, when ripe, they adhere to the coats of animals. Most of these vegetables, he remarks, require a soil enriched with dung. Few have failed to mark the locks of wool hanging on the thorn-bushes, wherever the sheep pass, and it is probable that the wolf or lion never give-chase to herbivorous animals without being unconsciously subservient to this part of the vegetable economy.

Animals' role in spreading plants.—But we’ve only looked at some of nature's resources for spreading seeds far from where they grow. Various animal species are actively helping in this process, which benefits them greatly. Sometimes, seeds have special features that allow them to cling to the fur of animals or the feathers of birds using prickles, hooks, and hairs. They can stay attached for weeks or even months and travel to wherever birds or mammals migrate. Linnæus identified fifty plant genera with these hooks that stick to animal fur when ripe, and the number known to botanists today is much higher. He notes that most of these plants thrive in nutrient-rich soil. Many have noticed wool trapped in thorn bushes wherever sheep roam, and it’s likely that predators like wolves or lions don’t chase herbivores without unknowingly contributing to this part of plant life.

A deer has strayed from the herd when browsing on some rich pasture, when he is suddenly alarmed by the approach of his foe. He instantly takes to flight, dashing through many a thicket, and swimming across many a river and lake. The seeds of the herbs and shrubs which have adhered to his smoking flanks are washed off again by the waters. The thorny spray is torn off, and fixes itself in its hairy coat, until brushed off again in other thickets and copses. Even on the spot where the victim is devoured many of the seeds which he had swallowed immediately before the chase may be left on the ground uninjured, and ready to spring up in a new soil.

A deer has wandered away from the herd while grazing on some lush grass when it suddenly gets startled by the approach of a predator. It immediately takes off, racing through various thickets and swimming across several rivers and lakes. The seeds from the plants and bushes that stuck to its sweating sides are washed away by the water. The thorny branches get pulled off and get stuck in its furry coat until they are eventually shaken off in other thickets and woods. Even at the spot where the deer is consumed, many of the seeds it swallowed just before the chase can be left on the ground unharmed, ready to grow in new soil.

The passage, indeed, of undigested seeds through the stomachs of animals is one of the most efficient causes of the dissemination of plants, and is of all others, perhaps, the most likely to be overlooked. Few are ignorant that a portion of the oats eaten by a horse preserve their germinating faculty in the dung. The fact of their being still nutritious is not lost on the sagacious rook. To many, says Linnæus, it seems extraordinary, and something of a prodigy, that when a field is well tilled and sown with the best wheat, it frequently produces darnel or the wild oat, 624 especially if it be manured with new dung; they do not consider that the fertility of the smaller seeds is not destroyed in the stomachs of animals.860

The passage of undigested seeds through animals' stomachs is one of the most effective ways that plants spread, and it’s often the most overlooked. Most people know that some of the oats eaten by a horse can still sprout from its dung. The fact that they remain nutritious isn’t missed by the clever rook. To many, Linnæus notes, it seems strange and almost miraculous that when a field is well-prepared and planted with high-quality wheat, it often ends up producing darnel or wild oats, especially if it’s fertilized with fresh dung; they fail to realize that the small seeds' ability to sprout isn't harmed in animals' stomachs.624860

Agency of birds.—Some birds of the order Passeres devour the seeds of plants in great quantities, which they eject again in very distant places, without destroying its faculty of vegetation: thus a flight of larks will fill the cleanest field with a great quantity of various kinds of plants, as the melilot trefoil (Medicago lupulina), and others whose seeds are so heavy that the wind is not able to scatter them to any distance.861 In like manner, the blackbird and misselthrush, when they devour berries in too great quantities, are known to consign them to the earth undigested in their excrement.862

Agency of birds.—Some birds from the order Passeres eat a lot of plant seeds and then drop them in distant locations, still capable of growing. For example, a group of larks will populate a clean field with a variety of plants, like melilot trefoil (Medicago lupulina), and other seeds that are too heavy for the wind to carry far.861 Similarly, blackbirds and mistle thrushes, after eating too many berries, often pass them undigested in their droppings.862

Pulpy fruits serve quadrupeds and birds as food, while their seeds, often hard and indigestible, pass uninjured through the intestines, and are deposited far from their original place of growth in a condition peculiarly fit for vegetation.863 So well are the farmers, in some parts of England, aware of this fact, that when they desire to raise a quickset hedge in the shortest possible time, they feed turkeys with the haws of the common white-thorn (Cratægus Oxyacantha), and then sow the stones which are ejected in their excrement, whereby they gain an entire year in the growth of the plant.864 Birds, when they pluck cherries, sloes, and haws, fly away with them to some convenient place; and when they have devoured the fruit, drop the stone into the ground. Captain Cook, in his account of the volcanic island of Tanna, one of the New Hebrides, which he visited in his second voyage, makes the following interesting observation:—"Mr. Forster, in his botanical excursion this day, shot a pigeon, in the craw of which was a wild nutmeg."865 It is easy, therefore, to perceive, that birds in their migrations to great distances, and even across seas, may transport seeds to new isles and continents.

Juicy fruits are food for four-legged animals and birds, while their seeds, which are often tough and hard to digest, pass through the intestines unharmed and are dropped far away from where they grew, perfectly ready for sprouting. 863 Farmers in some parts of England know this so well that when they want to quickly grow a hedge, they feed turkeys the haws of the common hawthorn (Cratægus Oxyacantha) and then plant the seeds that come out in their droppings, saving a whole year on the plant's growth. 864 When birds pick cherries, sloes, and haws, they carry them off to a good spot; after eating the fruit, they drop the seed on the ground. Captain Cook, during his visit to the volcanic island of Tanna in the New Hebrides on his second voyage, made an interesting observation:—"Mr. Forster, on his botanical trip today, shot a pigeon, which had a wild nutmeg in its crop." 865 It's clear that birds, during their long migrations, even across oceans, can transport seeds to new islands and continents.

The sudden deaths to which great numbers of frugivorous birds are annually exposed must not be omitted as auxiliary to the transportation of seeds to new habitations. When the sea retires from the shore, and leaves fruits and seeds on the beach, or in the mud of estuaries, it might, by the returning tide, wash them away again, or destroy them by long immersion; but when they are gathered by land birds which frequent the sea side, or by waders and water-fowl, they are often borne inland; and if the bird to whose crop they have been consigned is killed, they may be left to grow up far from the sea. Let such an accident happen but once in a century, or a thousand years, it will be sufficient to spread many of the plants from one continent to another; for in estimating the activity of these causes, we must not consider whether they act slowly in relation 625 to the period of our observation, but in reference to the duration of species in general.

The sudden deaths that many fruit-eating birds face every year should not be overlooked as a factor in spreading seeds to new locations. When the tide recedes from the shore, it leaves fruits and seeds on the beach or in the mud of estuaries. These seeds might be washed away again by the returning tide or ruined by being submerged for too long. However, when land birds that live near the sea, waders, or waterfowl collect them, they often carry them inland. If the bird carrying the seeds dies, the seeds may be left to grow far from the sea. Even if such an event occurs only once every century or once every thousand years, it can still be enough to spread many plants from one continent to another. When we assess how effective these processes are, we shouldn’t just think about how slowly they happen over our observation period, but rather in terms of how long species have existed overall.

Let us trace the operation of this cause in connection with others. A tempestuous wind bears the seeds of a plant many miles through the air, and then delivers them to the ocean; the oceanic current drifts them to a distant continent; by the fall of the tide they become the food of numerous birds, and one of these is seized by a hawk or eagle, which, soaring across hill and dale to a place of retreat, leaves, after devouring its prey, the unpalatable seeds to spring up and flourish in a new soil.

Let's follow how this cause interacts with others. A strong wind carries the seeds of a plant for miles through the air and drops them into the ocean; the ocean current then takes them to a faraway continent. When the tide goes out, they become food for various birds, and one of those birds gets caught by a hawk or eagle, which, flying over hills and valleys to a safe spot, leaves behind the uneaten seeds after it eats its meal, allowing them to grow and thrive in new soil.

The machinery before adverted to, is so capable of disseminating seeds over almost unbounded spaces, that were we more intimately acquainted with the economy of nature, we might probably explain all the instances which occur of the aberration of plants to great distances from their native countries. The real difficulty which must present itself to every one who contemplates the present geographical distribution of species, is the small number of exceptions to the rule of the non-intermixture of different groups of plants. Why have they not, supposing them to have been ever so distinct originally, become more blended and confounded together in the lapse of ages?

The machinery mentioned earlier is so effective at spreading seeds over vast distances that if we were more familiar with how nature works, we could likely explain all the instances of plants straying far from their original homes. The real challenge for anyone looking at the current geographical spread of species is the surprisingly small number of exceptions to the rule that different groups of plants don't mix. Why haven't they, even if they were originally very distinct, blended and mixed more over the ages?

Agency of man in the dispersion of plants.—But in addition to all the agents already enumerated as instrumental in diffusing plants over the globe, we have still to consider man—one of the most important of all. He transports with him, into every region, the vegetables which he cultivates for his wants, and is the involuntary means of spreading a still greater number which are useless to him, or even noxious. "When the introduction of cultivated plants," says De Candolle, "is of recent date, there is no difficulty in tracing their origin; but when it is of high antiquity, we are often ignorant of the true country of the plants on which we feed. No one contests the American origin of the maize or the potatoe; nor the origin, in the Old World, of the coffee-tree, and of wheat. But there are certain objects of culture, of very ancient date, between the tropics, such for example as the banana, of which the origin cannot be verified. Armies, in modern times, have been known to carry, in all directions, grain and cultivated vegetables from one extremity of Europe to the other; and thus have shown us how, in more ancient times, the conquests of Alexander, the distant expeditions of the Romans, and afterwards the crusades, may have transported many plants from one part of the world to the other."866

The role of humans in spreading plants.—In addition to all the factors already mentioned that help spread plants around the world, we also need to consider humans—one of the most significant agents of all. People take the plants they cultivate for their needs into various regions, and they unintentionally help to spread even more plants that are either useless to them or harmful. "When the introduction of cultivated plants," says De Candolle, "is recent, it's easy to trace their origin; but when it goes back a long time, we often don't know where the plants we rely on originally came from. No one disputes that maize and potatoes are native to the Americas; nor that the coffee tree and wheat originated in the Old World. However, there are some items of cultivation, very ancient ones, found between the tropics, like the banana, whose origins remain uncertain. In modern times, armies have been known to transport grains and cultivated vegetables in every direction across Europe; this illustrates how, in earlier times, Alexander's conquests, the far-reaching campaigns of the Romans, and later the Crusades could have moved many plants from one part of the world to another."866

But, besides the plants used in agriculture, the numbers which have been naturalized by accident, or which man has spread unintentionally, is considerable. One of our old authors, Josselyn, gives a catalogue of such plants as had, in his time, sprung up in the colony since the English planted and kept cattle in New England. They were two-and-twenty in number. The common nettle was the first which the settlers noticed; and the plantain was called by the Indians "Englishman's foot," as if it sprung from their footsteps.867

But aside from the plants that are grown for farming, there are also many that have naturalized by chance or that humans have spread unintentionally. One of our earlier writers, Josselyn, provides a list of plants that had appeared in the colony since the English arrived and began raising livestock in New England. There were twenty-two in total. The settlers first noticed the common nettle, and the plantain was referred to by the Indians as "Englishman's foot," as if it grew from their footsteps.867

626 "We have introduced every where," observes De Candolle, "some weeds which grow among our various kinds of wheat, and which have been received, perhaps, originally from Asia along with them. Thus, together with the Barbary wheat, the inhabitants of the south of Europe have sown, for many ages, the plants of Algiers and Tunis. With the wools and cottons of the East, or of Barbary, there are often brought into France the grains of exotic plants, some of which naturalize themselves. Of this I will cite a striking example. There is, at the gate of Montpellier, a meadow set apart for drying foreign wool, after it has been washed. There hardly passes a year without foreign plants being found naturalized in this drying-ground. I have gathered there Centaurea parviflora, Psoralea palæstina, and Hypericum crispum." This fact is not only illustrative of the aid which man lends inadvertently to the propagation of plants, but it also demonstrates the multiplicity of seeds which are borne about in the woolly and hairy coats of wild animals.

626 "We have introduced weeds everywhere," notes De Candolle, "that grow among our different types of wheat, and these may have originally come from Asia along with them. For many generations, along with Barbary wheat, the people in southern Europe have also sown plants from Algiers and Tunis. With the wool and cotton from the East or Barbary, grains of exotic plants are often brought into France, some of which adapt and grow here. A clear example of this is found at the gate of Montpellier, where there’s a field designated for drying foreign wool, after it has been washed. Almost every year, foreign plants are discovered naturalized in this drying area. I have collected Centaurea parviflora, Psoralea palæstina, and Hypericum crispum there." This observation not only highlights how humans unintentionally contribute to the spread of plants but also shows the vast number of seeds carried by the woolly and hairy coats of wild animals.

The same botanist mentions instances of plants naturalized in seaports by the ballast of ships; and several examples of others which have spread through Europe from botanical gardens, so as to have become more common than many indigenous species.

The same botanist notes cases of plants becoming established in seaports through the ballast of ships, along with several examples of others that have spread across Europe from botanical gardens, making them more common than many native species.

It is scarcely a century, says Linnæus, since the Canadian erigeron, or flea-bane, was brought from America to the botanical garden at Paris; and already the seeds have been carried by the winds so that it is diffused over France, the British islands, Italy, Sicily, Holland, and Germany.868 Several others are mentioned by the Swedish naturalist, as having been dispersed by similar means. The common thorn-apple (Datura Stramonium), observes Willdenow, now grows as a noxious weed throughout all Europe, with the exception of Sweden, Lapland and Russia. It came from the East Indies and Abyssinia to us, and was thus universally spread by certain quacks, who used its seeds as an emetic.869 The same plant is now abundant throughout the greater part of the United States, along road-sides and about farm-yards. The yellow monkey-flower, Mimulus luteus, a plant from the north-west region of America, has now established itself in various parts of England, and is spreading rapidly.

It’s been hardly a century, according to Linnæus, since the Canadian erigeron, or flea-bane, was brought from America to the botanical garden in Paris; and already the seeds have been carried by the winds, spreading it across France, the British Isles, Italy, Sicily, Holland, and Germany.868 Several other plants are noted by the Swedish naturalist as being spread in similar ways. The common thorn-apple (Datura Stramonium), as Willdenow points out, now grows as a troublesome weed throughout all of Europe, except in Sweden, Lapland, and Russia. It was brought from the East Indies and Abyssinia to us, and was thus widely spread by certain quacks who used its seeds as an emetic.869 This same plant is now widespread across much of the United States, found along roadsides and around farmyards. The yellow monkey-flower, Mimulus luteus, a plant from the north-west region of America, has now taken root in various parts of England and is spreading quickly.

In hot and ill-cultivated countries, such naturalization takes place more easily. Thus the Chenopodium ambrosioides, sown by Mr. Burchell on a point of St. Helena, multiplied so fast in four years as to become one of the commonest weeds in the island, and it has maintained its ground ever since 1845.870

In hot and poorly managed countries, this type of naturalization happens more easily. For example, the Chenopodium ambrosioides, planted by Mr. Burchell on a spot in St. Helena, spread so rapidly in four years that it became one of the most common weeds on the island, and it has continued to thrive since 1845.870

The most remarkable proof, says De Candolle, of the extent to which man is unconsciously the instrument of dispersing and naturalizing species, is found in the fact, that in New Holland, America, and the Cape of Good Hope, the aboriginal European species exceed in number all the others which have come from any distant regions; so that, in this instance, the influence of man has surpassed that of all the other causes which tend 627 to disseminate plants to remote districts. Of nearly 1600 British flowering plants, it is supposed that about 300 species are naturalized; but a large proportion of these would perish with the discontinuance of agriculture.

The most remarkable evidence, according to De Candolle, of how much humans unknowingly contribute to spreading and establishing species can be seen in New Holland, America, and the Cape of Good Hope, where the native European species outnumber all others that have arrived from distant regions. In this case, the impact of humans has surpassed all other factors that help spread plants to far-off places. Out of nearly 1600 British flowering plants, it’s estimated that around 300 species are naturalized, but many of these would die off if agriculture were to stop. 627

Although we are but slightly acquainted, as yet, with the extent of our instrumentality in naturalizing species, yet the facts ascertained afford no small reason to suspect that the number which we introduce unintentionally exceeds all those transported by design. Nor is it unnatural to suppose that the functions, which the inferior beings, extirpated by man, once discharged in the economy of nature, should devolve upon the human race. If we drive many birds of passage from different countries, we are probably required to fulfil their office of carrying seeds, eggs of fish, insects, mollusks, and other creatures, to distant regions: if we extirpate quadrupeds, we must replace them not merely as consumers of the animal and vegetable substances which they devour, but as disseminators of plants, and of the inferior classes of the animal kingdom. I do not mean to insinuate that the very same changes which man brings about, would have taken place by means of the agency of other species, but merely that he supersedes a certain number of agents; and so far as he disperses plants unintentionally, or against his will, his intervention is strictly analogous to that of the species so extirpated.

Although we are still only a bit familiar with how much we influence the naturalization of species, the facts we've discovered provide plenty of reason to believe that the number we unintentionally introduce is greater than those we move intentionally. It's not unreasonable to think that the roles previously filled by the lower beings eliminated by humans should now fall to us. If we drive many migratory birds away from various countries, we likely need to take on their job of transporting seeds, fish eggs, insects, mollusks, and other creatures to far-off places. If we eliminate certain mammals, we not only have to replace them as consumers of the plants and animals they eat but also as distributors of plants and the lower levels of the animal kingdom. I’m not suggesting that the exact same changes brought about by humans would have happened through other species' actions, but simply that humans replace a certain number of agents. Insofar as humans unintentionally spread plants or do so against their will, their role is quite similar to that of the species that have been eliminated.

I may observe, moreover, that if, at former periods, the animals inhabiting any given district have been partially altered by the extinction of some species, and the introduction of others, whether by new creations or by immigration, a change must have taken place in regard to the particular plants conveyed about with them to foreign countries. As, for example, when one set of migratory birds is substituted for another, the countries from and to which seeds are transported are immediately changed. Vicissitudes, therefore, analogous to those which man has occasioned, may have previously attended the springing up of new relations between species in the vegetable and animal worlds.

I should point out that in earlier times, if the animals living in a certain area were partially changed due to the extinction of some species and the introduction of others—whether through new creations or migration—a shift must have occurred in the specific plants that traveled with them to other countries. For instance, when one group of migratory birds is replaced by another, the regions from which and to which seeds are carried are instantly altered. Therefore, changes similar to those caused by humans may have previously influenced the emergence of new relationships between species in both the plant and animal kingdoms.

It may also be remarked, that if man is the most active agent in enlarging, so also is he in circumscribing the geographical boundaries of particular plants. He promotes the migration of some, he retards that of other species; so that, while in many respects he appears to be exerting his power to blend and confound the various provinces of indigenous species, he is, in other ways, instrumental in obstructing the fusion into one group of the inhabitants of contiguous provinces.

It can also be noted that while humans are the primary force in expanding the geographical range of certain plants, they also have a role in restricting it. They facilitate the movement of some species, while slowing down the spread of others. So, while it may seem that humans are blending and confusing the various natural areas of native species, they are also, in other ways, preventing the merging of the residents of neighboring regions into a single group.

Thus, for example, when two botanical regions exist in the same great continent, such as the European region, comprehending the central parts of Europe, and those surrounding the Mediterranean, and the Oriental region, as it has been termed, embracing the countries adjoining the Black Sea and the Caspian, the interposition between these of thousands of square miles of cultivated lands, opposes a new and powerful barrier against the mutual interchange of indigenous plants. Botanists are well aware that garden plants naturalize and diffuse themselves with great facility in comparatively unreclaimed countries, but spread themselves slowly and 628 with difficulty in districts highly cultivated. There are many obvious causes for this difference; by drainage and culture the natural variety of stations is diminished, and those stray individuals by which the passage of a species from one fit station to another is effected, are no sooner detected by the agriculturist, than they are uprooted as weeds. The larger shrubs and trees, in particular, can scarcely ever escape observation, when they have attained a certain size, and will rarely fail to be cut down if unprofitable.

So, for example, when there are two botanical regions on the same large continent, like the European region, which includes central parts of Europe and areas around the Mediterranean, and the Oriental region, as it’s called, covering the countries next to the Black Sea and the Caspian, the thousands of square miles of cultivated land between them create a significant barrier to the exchange of native plants. Botanists know that garden plants can easily establish themselves and spread in relatively uncultivated areas, but in highly cultivated regions, their spread is slow and challenging. There are many clear reasons for this difference; effective drainage and cultivation reduce the variety of natural environments, and any random plants that manage to make the transition from one suitable area to another are quickly noticed by farmers and removed as weeds. Larger shrubs and trees, in particular, are hard to miss once they reach a certain size and are often cut down if they aren’t useful.

The same observations are applicable to the interchange of the insects, birds, and quadrupeds of two regions situated like those above alluded to. No beasts of prey are permitted to make their way across the intervening arable tracts. Many birds, and hundreds of insects, which would have found some palatable food amongst the various herbs and trees of the primeval wilderness, are unable to subsist on the olive, the vine, the wheat, and a few trees and grasses favored by man. In addition, therefore, to his direct intervention, man, in this case, operates indirectly to impede the dissemination of plants, by intercepting the migration of animals, many of which would otherwise have been active in transporting seeds from one province to another.

The same observations apply to the exchange of insects, birds, and mammals between two regions that are similar to those mentioned earlier. No predators are allowed to cross the farmland in between. Many birds and countless insects that would have found suitable food among the various plants and trees in the original wilderness can’t thrive on the olive, the vine, the wheat, and a few trees and grasses that humans prefer. In addition to his direct influence, humans also indirectly hinder the spread of plants by blocking animal migration, as many animals would’ve played a role in moving seeds from one area to another.

Whether, in the vegetable kingdom, the influence of man will tend, after a considerable lapse of ages, to render the geographical range of species in general more extended, as De Candolle seems to anticipate, or whether the compensating agency above alluded to will not counterbalance the exceptions caused by our naturalizations, admits at least of some doubt. In the attempt to form an estimate on this subject, we must be careful not to underrate, or almost overlook, as some appear to have done, the influence of man in checking the diffusion of plants, and restricting their distribution to narrower limits.

Whether, in the plant world, human influence will eventually expand the geographic range of species in general, as De Candolle seems to predict, or whether the compensating factors mentioned earlier will offset the exceptions caused by our introduced species, is still uncertain. In trying to assess this issue, we need to be cautious not to underestimate, or nearly ignore, as some have, the impact of humans in limiting the spread of plants and confining their distribution to smaller areas.


CHAPTER XXXVIII.

LAWS WHICH REGULATE THE GEOGRAPHICAL DISTRIBUTION OF SPECIES—continued.

Geographical distribution of animals—Buffon on specific distinctness of quadrupeds of Old and New World—Doctrine of "natural barriers"—Different regions of indigenous mammalia—Europe—Africa—India, and Indian Archipelago—Australia—North and South America—Quadrupeds in islands—Range of the Cetacea—Dispersion of quadrupeds—Their powers of swimming—Migratory instincts—Drifting of animals on ice-floes—On floating islands of drift-timber—Migrations of Cetacea—Habitations of birds—Their migrations and facilities of diffusion—Distribution of reptiles, and their power of dissemination.

Geographical distribution of animals—Buffon on the distinct differences of mammals from the Old and New Worlds—The idea of "natural barriers"—Different areas of native mammals—Europe—Africa—India and the Indian Archipelago—Australia—North and South America—Mammals on islands—The range of cetaceans—The spread of mammals—Their swimming abilities—Migratory instincts—Animals drifting on ice floes—On floating islands made of driftwood—Migrations of cetaceans—Bird habitats—Their migrations and ability to spread—Distribution of reptiles and their means of propagation.

Geographical distribution of animals.—Although in speculating on "philosophical possibilities," said Buffon, "the same temperature might have been expected, all other circumstances being equal, to produce the same beings in different parts of the globe, both in the animal and vegetable kingdoms, yet it is an undoubted fact, that when America was discovered, its indigenous quadrupeds were all dissimilar to those previously known in the Old World. The elephant, the rhinoceros, the hippopotamus, the camelopard, the camel, the dromedary, the buffalo, the horse, the ass, the lion, the tiger, the apes, the baboons, and a number of other mammalia, were nowhere to be met with on the new continent; while in the old, the American species, of the same great class, were nowhere to be seen—the tapir, the lama, the pecari, the jaguar, the couguar, the agouti, the paca, the coati, and the sloth."

Geographical distribution of animals.—While speculating on "philosophical possibilities," Buffon stated, "under the same temperature, and all other conditions being equal, we might expect to find the same creatures in different parts of the world, both in the animal and plant kingdoms. However, it is a well-known fact that when America was discovered, its native mammals were completely different from those already known in the Old World. The elephant, rhinoceros, hippopotamus, giraffe, camel, dromedary, buffalo, horse, donkey, lion, tiger, apes, baboons, and many other mammals were absent from the new continent; meanwhile, in the old continent, the American species of the same large group were nowhere to be found—the tapir, llama, peccary, jaguar, cougar, agouti, paca, coati, and sloth."

These phenomena, although few in number relatively to the whole animate creation, were so striking and so positive in their nature, that the great French naturalist caught sight at once of a general law in the geographical distribution of organic beings, namely, the limitation of groups of distinct species to regions separated from the rest of the globe by certain natural barriers. It was, therefore, in a truly philosophical spirit that, relying on the clearness of the evidence obtained respecting the larger quadrupeds, he ventured to call in question the identifications announced by some contemporary naturalists of species of animals said to be common to the southern extremities of America and Africa.871

These phenomena, though relatively few compared to all living things, were so striking and undeniable that the great French naturalist immediately recognized a general rule in how organic beings are distributed geographically: distinct species are limited to areas separated from the rest of the world by certain natural barriers. Thus, with a truly philosophical mindset and confidence in the clear evidence gathered about larger mammals, he dared to question the identifications made by some contemporary naturalists regarding animal species claimed to be common to the southern ends of America and Africa.871

The migration of quadrupeds from one part of the globe to another, observes Dr. Prichard, is prevented by uncongenial climates and the branches of the ocean which intersect continents. "Hence, by a 630 reference to the geographical site of countries, we may divide the earth into a certain number of regions fitted to become the abodes of particular groups of animals, and we shall find, on inquiry, that each of these provinces, thus conjecturally marked out, is actually inhabited by a distinct nation of quadrupeds."872 It will be observed that the language of Buffon respecting "natural barriers," which has since been so popular, would be wholly without meaning if the geographical distribution of organic beings had not led naturalists to adopt very generally the doctrine of specific centres, or, in other words, to believe that each species, whether of plant or animal, originated in a single birth-place. Reject this view, and the fact that not a single native quadruped is common to Australia, the Cape of Good Hope, and South America, can in no ways be explained by adverting to the wide extent of intervening ocean, or to the sterile deserts, or the great heat or cold of the climates, through which each species must have passed, before it could migrate from one of those distant regions to another. It might fairly be asked of one who talked of impassable barriers, why the same kangaroos, rhinoceroses, or lamas, should not have been created simultaneously in Australia, Africa, and South America! The horse, the ox, and the dog, although foreign to these countries until introduced by man, are now able to support themselves there in a wild state, and we can scarcely doubt that many of the quadrupeds at present peculiar to Australia, Africa, and South America, might have continued in like manner to inhabit each of the three continents had they been indigenous or could they once have got a footing there as new colonists.

The movement of four-legged animals from one part of the world to another, notes Dr. Prichard, is restricted by unwelcoming climates and the oceans that separate continents. "Thus, by looking at the geographical location of countries, we can divide the Earth into a number of regions suitable for specific groups of animals, and upon investigation, we will find that each of these regions, as hypothesized, is actually populated by a distinct group of quadrupeds." 630 It should be noted that Buffon's idea about "natural barriers," which has become quite popular, would make no sense if the geographical distribution of living beings hadn't led naturalists to widely accept the idea of specific centers, or in simpler terms, to believe that each species, whether plant or animal, originated in a single location. Disregard this perspective, and the fact that no native quadrupeds are found in Australia, the Cape of Good Hope, and South America can hardly be explained by referencing the vast stretches of ocean in between, the barren deserts, or the extreme heat or cold of the climates that each species would have to cross to migrate from one of those distant regions to another. One might reasonably ask someone who speaks of insurmountable barriers, why the same kangaroos, rhinoceroses, or llamas shouldn't have been created at the same time in Australia, Africa, and South America! The horse, the cow, and the dog, although not native to these areas until brought in by humans, can now survive there in the wild, and we can hardly doubt that many of the quadrupeds currently unique to Australia, Africa, and South America could have similarly thrived on each of the three continents if they had been native or had once established themselves there as new settlers.

At the same time every zoologist will be willing to concede, that even if the departure of each species from a single centre had not appeared to be part of the plan of Nature, the range of species in general must have become limited, under the influence of a variety of causes, especially in the class of terrestrial mammalia. Scarcely any one of these could be expected to retain as fair a claim to the title of cosmopolite as man, although even the human race, fitted as it is by its bodily constitution and intellectual resources to spread very widely over the earth, is far from being strictly cosmopolite. It is excluded both from the arctic and antarctic circles, from many a wide desert and the summits of many mountain-chains; and lastly, from three-fourths of the globe covered by water, where there are large areas very prolific in animal life, even in the highest order of the vertebrate class. But the habitations of species are, as before stated, in reference to plants (see above, p. 614), circumscribed by causes different from those which determine their stations, and these causes are clearly connected with the time and place of the original creation of each species.

At the same time, every zoologist would agree that even if the spread of each species from a single center didn't seem to be part of Nature's plan, the overall range of species must have become limited due to various factors, especially among land mammals. Hardly any of these can really be called cosmopolitan like humans. Even though humans are physically and intellectually capable of spreading widely across the Earth, they certainly aren’t strictly cosmopolitan. They are excluded from the Arctic and Antarctic regions, from many vast deserts, and the peaks of many mountain ranges, as well as from three-quarters of the globe that’s covered by water, where there are large areas rich in animal life, even among the upper tiers of vertebrates. However, the habitats of species, as previously mentioned regarding plants (see above, p. 614), are limited by different factors than those that affect their stations, and these factors are clearly linked to the time and place of each species' original creation.

As the names and characters of land quadrupeds are much better 631 known to the general reader than those of other great families of the animal kingdom, I shall select this class to exemplify the zoological provinces into which species are divisible, confining myself, however, to those facts which may help to elucidate some principle, or rule apparently followed by the Author of Nature, in regard to that "mystery of mysteries," the first peopling of the earth with living beings.873 First, then, the European region comprehends, besides Europe, the borders of the Mediterranean, and even the north of Africa, and extends into Asia, beyond the Oural mountains and the Caspian. Although the species are almost all peculiar, the number of characteristic genera is remarkably small. The bear, the fox, the hare, the rabbit, the deer, and almost every European form is found equally in several of the other large provinces of mammalia, where the species are distinct. Even the mole (Talpa), although confined to the northern parts of the old world, ranges eastwards, as far as the Himalaya mountains.

As the names and characteristics of land mammals are much better known to the average reader than those of other major groups in the animal kingdom, I will choose this category to illustrate the zoological regions into which species can be divided. However, I will limit myself to facts that may help clarify some principle or rule seemingly followed by the Creator of Nature regarding that "mystery of mysteries," the initial populating of the earth with living beings.873 First, then, the European region includes, in addition to Europe, the Mediterranean coast, and even the north of Africa, extending into Asia, beyond the Ural mountains and the Caspian Sea. Although almost all the species are unique, the number of characteristic genera is notably small. The bear, the fox, the hare, the rabbit, the deer, and nearly every European species can also be found in several other major mammal regions, where the species are different. Even the mole (Talpa), though limited to the northern parts of the Old World, ranges eastward as far as the Himalaya mountains.

2dly. The African Fauna, on the other hand, is singularly rich in generic forms, not met with in a living state in any other region. The hippopotamus, for example, of which two very distinct species are known, the giraffe, the Chimpanzee, the blue-faced baboon, the four-fingered monkeys (Colubus), many carnivora, such as Proteles, allied to the hyæna, and a multitude of other forms, are exclusively African. A few of the species inhabiting the northern confines of this continent, such as the dromedary, lion, and jackall, are also common to Asia; and a much larger number of forms belong equally to the great Asiatic province, the species being distinct. The elephant, for example, of Africa is smaller, has a rounder head, and larger ears than the Indian one, and has only three instead of four nails on each hind foot. In like manner, not one of three African species of Rhinoceros agrees with one of the three Indian kinds.

2dly. The African fauna is uniquely rich in species not found alive in any other region. The hippopotamus, for example, has two very distinct species, along with the giraffe, the chimpanzee, the blue-faced baboon, the four-fingered monkeys (Colubus), many carnivores like Proteles, which is related to the hyena, and a multitude of other forms that are exclusively African. Some species living in the northern part of this continent, such as the dromedary, lion, and jackal, are also found in Asia, and a much larger number of forms exist in both the African and Asian regions, though the species themselves are different. For instance, the African elephant is smaller, has a rounder head, and larger ears than the Indian elephant, and it has only three nails instead of four on each hind foot. Similarly, none of the three African species of rhinoceros matches any of the three Indian species.

3dly. The Southern region of Africa, where that continent extends into the temperate zone, constitutes another separate zoological province, surrounded as it is on three sides by the ocean, and cut off from the countries of milder climate in the northern hemisphere, by the intervening torrid zone. In many instances, this region contains the same genera which are found in temperate climates to the northward of the line: but then the southern are different from the northern species. Thus, in the south we find the quagga and the zebra; in the north, the horse, the ass, and the jiggetai of Asia.

3dly. The Southern region of Africa, where the continent reaches into the temperate zone, makes up another distinct zoological area, surrounded on three sides by the ocean and separated from the milder climates of the northern hemisphere by the hot zone in between. In many cases, this region has the same genera that are found in the temperate climates to the north of the equator, but the southern species are different from those in the north. So, in the south, we find the quagga and the zebra; while in the north, there are the horse, the donkey, and the jiggetai from Asia.

The south of Africa is spread out into fine level plains from the tropic to the Cape. In this region, says Pennant, besides the horse genus, of which five species have been found, there are also peculiar species of 632 rhinoceros, the hog, and the hyrax, among pachydermatous races; and amongst the ruminating, the Cape buffalo, and a variety of remarkable antelopes, as the springbok, the oryx, the gnou, the leucophoë, the pygarga, and several others.874

The southern part of Africa features vast, flat plains stretching from the tropics to the Cape. In this area, Pennant notes that, in addition to the horse family, which includes five known species, there are also unique species of 632 rhinoceros, hogs, and hyraxes among the thick-skinned animals. Among the herbivores, you'll find the Cape buffalo and a variety of notable antelopes, including the springbok, oryx, gnu, leucophoë, pygarga, and several others.874

4thly. The assemblage of quadrupeds in Madagascar affords a striking illustration of the laws before alluded to, as governing the distribution of species in islands. Separated from Africa by the Mozambique channel, which is 300 miles wide, Madagascar forms, with two or three small islands in its immediate vicinity, a zoological province by itself, all the species except one, and nearly all the genera, being peculiar. The only exception consists of a small insectivorous quadruped (Centetes), found also in the Mauritius, to which place it is supposed to have been taken in ships. The most characteristic feature of this remarkable fauna consists in the number of quadrumana of the Lemur family, no less than six genera of these monkeys being exclusively met with in this island, and a seventh genus of the same, called Galago, which alone has any foreign representative, being found, as we might from analogy have anticipated, in the nearest main land. Had the species of quadrupeds in Madagascar agreed with those of the contiguous parts of Africa, as do those of England with the rest of Europe, the naturalist would have inferred that there had been a land communication since the period of the coming in of the existing quadrupeds, whereas we may now conclude that the Mozambique channel has constituted an insuperable barrier to the fusion of the continental fauna with that of the great island during the whole period that has elapsed since the living species were created.

4th. The collection of mammals in Madagascar provides a striking example of the principles mentioned earlier about how species are distributed on islands. Separated from Africa by the Mozambique Channel, which is 300 miles wide, Madagascar, along with a few small nearby islands, forms its own zoological region, where all species except one and nearly all genera are unique. The only exception is a small insect-eating mammal (Centetes), also found in Mauritius, which is thought to have been brought there by ships. A key feature of this unique wildlife is the number of lemurs, as there are six genera of these monkeys that are only found on this island, along with a seventh genus called Galago, which has a foreign counterpart located in the nearest mainland, as we might have guessed from similarities. If the mammal species in Madagascar had matched those in the nearby parts of Africa, like how England's species align with the rest of Europe, a naturalist would have concluded there was a land connection since the current mammals arrived. However, we can now conclude that the Mozambique Channel has created an unbridgeable barrier to the mixing of the mainland wildlife with that of this large island throughout the entire time since the living species were created.

5thly. Another of the great nations of terrestrial mammalia is that of India, containing a great variety of peculiar forms, such as the sloth-bear (Prochilus), the musk-deer (Moscus), the nylghau, the gibbon or long-armed ape, and many others.

5thly. Another one of the major nations of land mammals is India, which has a wide variety of unique species, such as the sloth bear (Prochilus), the musk deer (Moscus), the nilgai, the gibbon or long-armed ape, and many others.

6thly. A portion of the islands of the Indian archipelago might, perhaps, be considered by some geologists as an appendage of the same province. In fact, we find in the large islands of Java, Sumatra, and Borneo, the same genera, for the most part, as on the continent of India, and some of the same species, e. g. the tapir (Tapirus Malayanus), the rhinoceros of Sumatra, and some others. Most of the species, however, are distinct, and each island has many, and even a few genera, peculiar to itself. Between eighty and ninety species are known to inhabit Java, and nearly the same number occur in Sumatra. Of these, more than half are common to the two islands. Borneo, which is much less explored, has yielded already upwards of sixty species, more than half of which are met with either in Java or Sumatra. Of the species inhabiting Sumatra and not found in Java, Borneo contains the greater portion. Upon the whole, if these three large islands were united, and a fusion of their respective indigenous mammalia should take place, they would present a fauna related to that of continental India, and comprising about as many species as 633 we might expect from analogy to discover in an area of equal extent. The Philippine Islands are peopled with another assemblage of species generically related to the great Indian type.

6thly. Some geologists might view parts of the Indian archipelago as an extension of the same area. In reality, the large islands of Java, Sumatra, and Borneo have mostly the same genera as those found on the Indian continent, with some identical species, like the tapir (Tapirus Malayanus), the Sumatran rhinoceros, and a few others. However, most species are unique, and each island has many, including a few genera, that are specific to it. About eighty to ninety species are known to inhabit Java, and nearly the same number is found in Sumatra. More than half of these species are common to both islands. Borneo, which is much less explored, has already revealed over sixty species, more than half of which are also found in either Java or Sumatra. Among the species inhabiting Sumatra but not found in Java, Borneo has a larger share. Overall, if these three large islands were combined, and their respective native mammals were to mix, they would have a fauna similar to that of continental India, with approximately as many species as 633 we could expect to find by analogy in a similarly sized area. The Philippine Islands are home to another group of species that are generically related to the major Indian type.

7thly. But the islands of Celebes, Amboina, Timor, and New Guinea, constitute a different region of mammalia more allied to the Australian type, as having an intermixture of marsupial quadrupeds, yet showing an affinity also to the Indian in such forms as the deer (Cervus), the weasel (Viverra), the pig (Sus), the Macaque monkey (Cercopithecus), and others. As we proceed in a south-westerly direction, from Celebes to Amboina and thence to New Guinea, we find the Indian types diminishing in number, and the Australian (i. e. marsupial forms) increasing. Thus in New Guinea seven species of pouched quadrupeds have been detected, and among them two singular tree-kangaroos; yet only one species of the whole seven, viz. the flying opossum (Petauris ariel), is common to the Indian archipelago and the main land of Australia. The greater the zoological affinity, therefore, between the latter and the New Guinea fauna, although it seems in some way connected with geographical proximity, is not to be explained simply by the mutual migration of species from the one to the other.

7thly. However, the islands of Celebes, Amboina, Timor, and New Guinea represent a distinct region of mammals that aligns more closely with the Australian type, as they have a mix of marsupial animals while also showing connections to Indian species such as deer (Cervus), weasels (Viverra), pigs (Sus), Macaque monkeys (Cercopithecus), and others. As we travel southwest from Celebes to Amboina and then to New Guinea, we observe a decrease in the number of Indian types and an increase in Australian (i.e. marsupial) forms. In New Guinea, seven species of pouch-bearing mammals have been identified, including two unique tree-kangaroos; yet only one of these species, the flying opossum (Petauris ariel), is common to both the Indian archipelago and mainland Australia. Thus, while there is a greater zoological similarity between the latter and the New Guinea fauna, which appears to be somewhat linked to geographical closeness, it cannot be explained solely by the movement of species between the two.

8thly. When Australia was discovered, its land quadrupeds, belonging almost exclusively to the marsupial or pouched tribe, such as the kangaroos, wombats, flying opossums, kangaroo-rats, and others, some feeding on herbs and fruits, others carnivorous, were so novel in their structure and aspect, that they appeared to the naturalist almost as strange as if they were the inhabitants of some other planet. We learn from the recent investigations of Mr. Waterhouse,875 that no less than 170 species of marsupial quadrupeds have now been determined, and of the whole number all but thirty-two are exclusively restricted to Australia. Of these thirty-two, nine belong to the islands in the Indian archipelago before mentioned, and the other twenty-three are all species of opossum inhabiting the tropical parts of South America, or a few of them extending into Mexico and California, and one, the Virginian opossum, into the United States.

8thly. When Australia was discovered, its land mammals were almost entirely marsupials, like kangaroos, wombats, flying opossums, kangaroo-rats, and others. Some fed on plants and fruits, while others were carnivorous. They were so unique in their structure and appearance that they seemed almost as strange to naturalists as if they came from another planet. We learn from the recent studies by Mr. Waterhouse,875 that at least 170 species of marsupial mammals have now been identified, and of all these, only thirty-two are found outside Australia. Of those thirty-two, nine are from the islands in the Indian archipelago mentioned earlier, and the other twenty-three are species of opossums found in the tropical regions of South America, with a few extending into Mexico and California, and one, the Virginian opossum, into the United States.

9thly. It only remains for me to say something of the mammiferous fauna of North and South America. It has often been said that, where the three continents of Asia, Europe, and North America, approach very near to each other towards the pole, the whole arctic region forms one zoological and botanical province. The narrow straits which separate the old and new world are frozen over in winter, and the distance is farther lessened by intervening islands. Many plants and animals of various classes have accordingly spread over all the arctic lands, being sometimes carried in the same manner as the polar bear, when it is drifted on floating ice from Greenland to Iceland. But on a close inspection of the arctic mammalia, it has been found of late years that a very small number of the American species are identical with those of 634 Europe or Asia. The genera are, in great part, the same or nearly allied; but the species are rarely identical, and are often very unlike, as in the case of the American badger and that of Europe. Some of the genera of arctic America, such as the musk ox (Ovibos), are quite peculiar, and the distinctness of the fauna of the great continents goes on increasing in proportion as we trace them southwards, or as they recede farther from each other, and become more and more separated by the ocean. At length we find that the three groups of tropical mammalia, belonging severally to America, Africa, and India, have not a single species in common.

9thly. I only need to mention something about the mammal species of North and South America. It’s often noted that where the three continents of Asia, Europe, and North America come close together near the North Pole, the entire Arctic region creates a single zoological and botanical province. The narrow straits that separate the old and new worlds freeze over in winter, and the distance is further shortened by intervening islands. Many plants and animals from different classes have spread across all the Arctic lands, sometimes drifting like the polar bear does, floating on ice from Greenland to Iceland. However, recent investigations into Arctic mammals have revealed that very few of the American species are identical to those found in 634 Europe or Asia. While the genera are mostly the same or closely related, the species rarely match and often differ significantly, as seen with the American badger compared to its European counterpart. Some of the genera in Arctic America, like the musk ox (Ovibos), are quite unique, and the differences in fauna between the large continents increase as we move southward or as they drift further apart, becoming more separated by the ocean. Ultimately, we find that the three groups of tropical mammals specific to America, Africa, and India don’t share a single species.

The predominant influence of climate over all the other causes which limit the range of species in the mammalia is perhaps nowhere so conspicuously displayed as in North America. The arctic fauna, so admirably described by Sir John Richardson, has scarcely any species in common with the fauna of the state of New York, which is 600 miles farther south, and comprises about forty distinct mammifers. If again we travel farther south about 600 miles, and enter another zone, running east and west, in South Carolina, Georgia, Alabama, and the contiguous states, we again meet with a new assemblage of land quadrupeds, and this again differs from the fauna of Texas, where frosts are unknown. It will be observed that on this continent there are no great geographical barriers running east and west, such as high snow-clad mountains, barren deserts, or wide arms of the sea, capable of checking the free migration of species from north to south. But notwithstanding the distinctness of those zones of indigenous mammalia, there are some species, such as the buffalo (Bison Americanus), the racoon (Procyon lotor), and the Virginian opossum (Didelphis Virginiana), which have a wider habitation, ranging almost from Canada to the Gulf of Mexico; but they form exceptions to the general rule. The opossum of Texas (Didelphis carnivora) is different from that of Virginia, and other species of the same genus inhabit westward of the Rocky Mountains, in California, for example, where almost all the mammalia differ from those of the United States.

The main impact of climate on the various factors that limit the distribution of species in mammals is perhaps most clearly seen in North America. The Arctic wildlife, described so well by Sir John Richardson, has almost no species in common with the wildlife of New York, which is 600 miles further south and includes about forty different mammals. If we travel another 600 miles south into another area that runs east to west, like South Carolina, Georgia, Alabama, and the nearby states, we encounter yet another different group of land mammals, which again differs from those in Texas, where frost is nonexistent. It’s worth noting that on this continent, there are no major geographical barriers running east and west, like high snowy mountains, harsh deserts, or wide seas, which could hinder the free movement of species from north to south. However, despite the distinctiveness of these zones of native mammals, there are some species, like the buffalo (Bison Americanus), the raccoon (Procyon lotor), and the Virginia opossum (Didelphis Virginiana), that have a broader range, spanning almost from Canada to the Gulf of Mexico; but they are exceptions to the general pattern. The Texas opossum (Didelphis carnivora) is different from the one in Virginia, and other species of the same genus are found west of the Rocky Mountains, for instance in California, where nearly all mammals differ from those in the United States.

10thly. The West Indian land quadrupeds are not numerous, but several of them are peculiar; and 11thly, South America is the most distinct, with the exception of Australia, of all the provinces into which the mammalia can be classed geographically. The various genera of monkeys, for example, belong to the family Platyrrhini, a large natural division of the quadrumana, so named from their widely separated nostrils. They have a peculiar dentition, and many of them prehensile tails, and are entirely unknown in other quarters of the globe. The sloths and armadillos, the true blood-sucking bats or vampyres (Phyllostomidæ), the capybara, the largest of the rodents, the carnivorous coatimondi (Nasua), and a great many other forms, are also exclusively characteristic of South America.

10thly. The West Indian land mammals aren’t many, but several are unique; and 11thly, South America is the most distinct, except for Australia, of all the regions into which mammals can be categorized geographically. For instance, the various types of monkeys belong to the family Platyrrhini, a large natural group of primates, named for their widely spaced nostrils. They have a unique dental structure, and many possess prehensile tails, completely absent in other parts of the world. The sloths and armadillos, true blood-sucking bats or vampyres (Phyllostomidæ), the capybara, the largest rodent, the carnivorous coatimundi (Nasua), and many other species are also distinctively characteristic of South America.

"In Peru and Chili," says Humboldt, "the region of the grasses, which is at an elevation of from 12,300 to 15,400 feet, is inhabited by 635 crowds of lama, guanaco, and alpaca. These quadrupeds, which here represent the genus camel of the ancient continent, have not extended themselves either to Brazil or Mexico; because, during their journey, they must necessarily have descended into regions that were too hot for them."876 In this passage it will be seen that the doctrine of "specific centres" is tacitly assumed.

"In Peru and Chile," Humboldt says, "the grasslands, located at elevations between 12,300 and 15,400 feet, are home to large populations of llama, guanaco, and alpaca. These animals, which here represent the camel species of the ancient continent, haven't spread to Brazil or Mexico because, during their migration, they would have had to descend into areas that are too hot for them."635 In this passage, it will be evident that the idea of "specific centers" is implicitly assumed.876

Quadrupeds in Islands.—Islands remote from continents, especially those of small size, are either destitute of quadrupeds, except such as have been conveyed to them by man, or contain species peculiar to them. In the Galapagos archipelago no indigenous quadrupeds were found except one mouse, which is supposed to be distinct from any hitherto found elsewhere. A peculiar species of fox is indigenous in the Falkland Islands, and a rat in New Zealand, which last country, notwithstanding its magnitude, is destitute of other mammalia, except bats, and these, says Dr. Prichard, may have made their way along the chain of islands which extend from the shores of New Guinea far into the Southern Pacific. The same author remarks, that among the various groups of fertile islands in the Pacific, no quadrupeds have been met with except the rat and a few bats as above mentioned, and the dog and hog, which appear to have been conveyed thither by the natives from New Guinea. "Rats are to be found even on some desert islands, whither they may have been conveyed by canoes which have occasionally approached the shore. It is known, also, that rats occasionally swim in large numbers to considerable distances."877

Quadrupeds in Islands.—Islands far from continents, especially small ones, either have no quadrupeds except those brought by humans, or they have species unique to those islands. In the Galapagos archipelago, only one indigenous quadruped was found, a mouse thought to be different from any discovered elsewhere. A unique species of fox is native to the Falkland Islands, and a rat is found in New Zealand, which, despite its size, lacks other mammals apart from bats. Dr. Prichard suggests that these bats might have traveled along a chain of islands stretching from New Guinea deep into the Southern Pacific. The same author points out that among the various fertile island groups in the Pacific, the only quadrupeds found are the rat and a few bats as mentioned, along with dogs and pigs, which were likely brought there by the locals from New Guinea. "Rats are even found on some uninhabited islands, possibly carried there by canoes that have occasionally come ashore. It's also known that rats sometimes swim long distances in large numbers."877

Geographical range of the Cetacea.—It is natural to suppose that the geographical range of the different species of Cetacea should be less correctly ascertained than that of the terrestrial mammifers. It is, however, well known that the whales which are obtained by our fishers in the South Seas are distinct from those of the North; and the same dissimilarity has been found in all the other marine animals, of the same class, so far as they have yet been studied by naturalists.

Geographical range of the Cetacea.—It makes sense to think that the geographical range of different species of cetaceans is not as accurately determined as that of land mammals. However, it's well known that the whales caught by fishermen in the South Seas are different from those in the North. The same difference has been observed in all other marine animals of this class, at least as much as naturalists have studied them so far.

Dispersion of quadrupeds.—Let us now inquire what facilities the various land quadrupeds enjoy of spreading themselves over the surface of the earth. In the first place, as their numbers multiply, all of them, whether they feed on plants, or prey on other animals, are disposed to scatter themselves gradually over as wide an area as is accessible to them. But before they have extended their migrations over a large space, they are usually arrested either by the sea, or a zone of uncongenial climate, or some lofty and unbroken chain of mountains, or a tract already occupied by a hostile and more powerful species.

Dispersion of quadrupeds.—Let’s now look into how different land mammals spread across the earth. First of all, as their populations grow, all of them, whether they eat plants or hunt other animals, tend to gradually spread out over as broad an area as they can access. However, before they can migrate across a large region, they are often stopped by the sea, an area with an unsuitable climate, a tall and continuous mountain range, or land already inhabited by a stronger and more aggressive species.

Their powers of swimming.—Rivers and narrow friths can seldom interfere with their progress; for the greater part of them swim well, and few are without this power when urged by danger and pressing want. Thus, amongst beasts of prey, the tiger is seen swimming about 636 among the islands and creeks in the delta of the Ganges, and the jaguar traverses with ease the largest streams in South America.878 The bear, also, and the bison, cross the current of the Mississippi. The popular error, that the common swine cannot escape by swimming when thrown into the water, has been contradicted by several curious and well-authenticated instances during the floods in Scotland of 1829. One pig, only six months old, after having been carried down from Garmouth to the bar at the mouth of the Spey, a distance of a quarter of a mile, swam four miles eastward to Port Gordon, and landed safe. Three others, of the same age and litter, swam, at the same time, five miles to the west, and landed at Blackhill.879

Their swimming abilities.—Rivers and narrow inlets rarely hinder their movement; most of them can swim well, and few lack this skill when faced with danger or urgent need. For example, among predators, tigers are often seen swimming around the islands and channels in the Ganges delta, while jaguars easily cross the biggest rivers in South America. The bear and the bison also manage to swim across the Mississippi River. The common misconception that pigs can't escape by swimming when thrown into water has been refuted by several interesting and well-documented cases during the floods in Scotland in 1829. One pig, just six months old, was carried from Garmouth to the bar at the mouth of the Spey, a distance of a quarter mile, and then swam four miles east to Port Gordon, where it safely landed. Three others, of the same age and litter, swam five miles to the west at the same time and landed at Blackhill.

In an adult and wild state, these animals would doubtless have been more strong and active, and might, when hard pressed, have performed a much longer voyage. Hence islands remote from the continent may obtain inhabitants by casualties which, like the late storms in Morayshire, may only occur once in many centuries, or thousands of years, under all the same circumstances. It is obvious that powerful tides, winds, and currents may sometimes carry along quadrupeds capable, in like manner, of preserving themselves for hours in the sea, to very considerable distances; and in this way, perhaps, the tapir (Tapir Indicus) may have become common to Sumatra and the Malayan peninsula.

In their natural and untamed state, these animals were likely stronger and more active, and when faced with challenges, they could have made much longer journeys. Therefore, remote islands might gain inhabitants through rare events, similar to the recent storms in Morayshire, which might only happen once every few centuries or even thousands of years under the same conditions. It’s clear that strong tides, winds, and currents can sometimes carry land animals that can, similarly, survive for hours at sea, traveling considerable distances. This might explain how the tapir (Tapir Indicus) could have spread across Sumatra and the Malay Peninsula.

To the elephant, in particular, the power of crossing rivers is essential in a wild state, for the quantity of food which a herd of these animals consumes renders it necessary that they should be constantly moving from place to place. The elephant crosses the stream in two ways. If the bed of the river be hard, and the water not of too great a depth, he fords it. But when he crosses great rivers, such as the Ganges and the Niger, the elephant swims deep, so deep, that the end of his trunk only is out of the water; for it is a matter of indifference to him whether his body be completely immersed, provided he can bring the tip of his trunk to the surface, so as to breathe the external air.

For the elephant, the ability to cross rivers is crucial in the wild because the amount of food a herd consumes requires them to continually move from place to place. The elephant has two ways to cross a stream. If the riverbed is hard and the water isn’t too deep, he simply wades through it. However, when he swims across larger rivers, like the Ganges and the Niger, he goes deep enough that only the tip of his trunk is above water; he doesn’t mind being fully submerged as long as he can keep the tip of his trunk above the surface to breathe.

Animals of the deer kind frequently take to the water, especially in the rutting season, when the stags are seen, swimming for several leagues at a time, from island to island, in search of the does, especially in the Canadian lakes; and in some countries where there are islands near the sea-shore, they fearlessly enter the sea and swim to them. In hunting excursions, in North America, the elk of that country is frequently pursued for great distances through the water.

Animals like deer often go into the water, especially during the mating season, when the males are seen swimming for miles, moving from island to island in search of females, particularly in the Canadian lakes. In some regions where islands are close to the coast, they bravely swim into the ocean to reach them. During hunting trips in North America, elk are often chased over long distances through the water.

The large herbivorous animals, which are gregarious, can never remain long in a confined region, as they consume so much vegetable food. The immense herds of bisons (Bos Americanus) which often, in the great valleys of the Mississippi and its tributaries blacken the 637 surface of the prairie lands, are continually shifting their quarters, followed by wolves, which prowl about in their rear. "It is no exaggeration," says Mr. James, "to assert, that in one place, on the banks of the Platte, at least ten thousand bisons burst on our sight in an instant. In the morning, we again sought the living picture; but upon all the plain, which last evening was so teeming with noble animals, not one remained."880

The large herbivorous animals, which are social, can't stay in one place for too long because they eat so much plant matter. The massive herds of bison (Bos Americanus) that often cover the prairie in the great valleys of the Mississippi and its tributaries are constantly moving, trailed by wolves that stalk them. "It's not an exaggeration," says Mr. James, "to say that at one spot on the banks of the Platte, we saw at least ten thousand bison appear before us all at once. In the morning, we tried to find that live scene again, but across the plains where there had been so many magnificent animals the night before, not a single one was left."880

Migratory instincts.—Besides the disposition common to the individuals of every species slowly to extend their range in search of food, in proportion as their numbers augment, a migratory instinct often developes itself in an extraordinary manner, when, after an unusually prolific season, or upon a sudden scarcity of provisions, great multitudes are threatened by famine. It may be useful to enumerate some examples of these migrations, because they may put us upon our guard against attributing a high antiquity to a particular species merely because it is diffused over a great space; they show clearly how soon, in a state of nature, a newly created species might spread itself, in every direction, from a single point.

Migratory instincts.—Along with the natural tendency of individuals of every species to gradually expand their range in search of food as their population grows, a migratory instinct can often develop remarkably, especially after a particularly abundant season or during a sudden shortage of resources, putting large numbers at risk of starvation. It may be helpful to list some examples of these migrations, as they can warn us against assuming that a species is ancient just because it covers a large area; they clearly demonstrate how quickly, in the wild, a newly formed species could spread out from a single location.

In very severe winters, great numbers of the black bears of America migrate from Canada into the United States; but in milder seasons, when they have been well fed, they remain and hybernate in the north.881 The rein-deer, which, in Scandinavia, can scarcely exist to the south of the sixty-fifth parallel, descends, in consequence of the greater coldness of the climate, to the fiftieth degree in Chinese Tartary, and often roves into a country of more southern latitude than any part of England.

In extremely harsh winters, many black bears from America migrate from Canada into the United States; but in milder seasons, when they’ve had enough to eat, they stay and hibernate up north.881 The reindeer, which can barely survive south of the sixty-fifth parallel in Scandinavia, moves down to the fiftieth degree in Chinese Tartary due to the colder climate, and often travels into areas further south than any part of England.

In Lapland, and other high latitudes, the common squirrels, whenever they are compelled, by want of provisions, to quit their usual abodes, migrate in amazing numbers, and travel directly forwards, allowing neither rocks nor forests, nor the broadest waters, to turn them from their course. Great numbers are often drowned in attempting to pass friths and rivers. In like manner the small Norway rat sometimes pursues its migrations in a straight line across rivers and lakes; and Pennant informs us, that when the rats, in Kamtschatka, become too numerous, they gather together in the spring, and proceed in great bodies westward, swimming over rivers, lakes, and arms of the sea. Many are drowned or destroyed by water-fowl or fish. As soon as they have crossed the river Penginsk, at the head of the gulf of the same name, they turn southward, and reach the rivers Judoma and Okotsk by the middle of July; a district more than 800 miles distant from their point of departure.

In Lapland and other northern regions, common squirrels, when they run out of food, leave their usual homes and migrate in huge numbers. They move straight ahead, not letting anything—rocks, forests, or even large bodies of water—sway them from their path. Many get drowned while trying to cross inlets and rivers. Similarly, the small Norway rat sometimes migrates in a direct line across rivers and lakes. Pennant tells us that when the rat population in Kamchatka gets too large, they gather in spring and head west in large groups, swimming over rivers, lakes, and coastal waters. Many are drowned or fall prey to birds or fish. After they cross the Penginsk River at the head of the gulf of the same name, they turn south and reach the Judoma and Okotsk rivers by mid-July, covering more than 800 miles from where they started.

The lemings, also, a small kind of rat, are described as natives of the mountains of Kolen, in Lapland; and once or twice in a quarter of a century they appear in vast numbers, advancing along the ground, and "devouring every green thing." Innumerable bands march from the 638 Kolen, through Nordland and Finmark, to the Western Ocean, which they immediately enter; and after swimming about for some time, perish. Other bands take their route through Swedish Lapland, to the Bothnian Gulf, where they are drowned in the same manner. They are followed in their journeys by bears, wolves, and foxes, which prey upon them incessantly. They generally move in lines, which are about three feet from each other, and exactly parallel, going directly forward through rivers and lakes; and when they meet with stacks of hay or corn, gnawing their way through them instead of passing round.882 These excursions usually precede a rigorous winter, of which the lemings seem in some way forewarned.

The lemmings, a small type of rat, are known to live in the mountains of Kolen in Lapland. Every twenty-five years or so, they appear in huge numbers, moving along the ground and "devouring every green thing." Countless groups travel from the Kolen through Nordland and Finmark to the Western Ocean, where they immediately enter the water; after swimming for a while, they die. Other groups take a different route through Swedish Lapland to the Bothnian Gulf, where they also drown in the same way. They are pursued on their journeys by bears, wolves, and foxes that constantly prey on them. They usually travel in lines that are about three feet apart and perfectly parallel, moving straight ahead through rivers and lakes; when they encounter stacks of hay or corn, they gnaw their way through them instead of going around. These migrations typically happen before a harsh winter, which the lemmings seem to sense in some way.

Fig. 97.The Leming, or Lapland Marmot (Mus Lemmus, Linn.)

The Leming, or Lapland Marmot (Mus Lemmus, Linn.)

The Leming, or Lapland Marmot (Mus Lemmus, Linn.)

Vast troops of the wild ass, or onager of the ancients, which inhabit the mountainous deserts of Great Tartary, feed, during the summer, in the tracts east and north of Lake Aral. In the autumn they collect in herds of hundreds, and even thousands, and direct their course towards Persia, to enjoy a warm retreat during winter.883 Bands of two or three hundred quaggas, a species of wild ass, are sometimes seen to migrate from the tropical plains of southern Africa to the vicinity of the Malaleveen River. During their migrations they are followed by lions, who slaughter them night by night.884

Large groups of wild asses, or onager as the ancients called them, live in the mountainous deserts of Great Tartary. In the summer, they graze in the areas east and north of Lake Aral. In the autumn, they gather in herds of hundreds, even thousands, and make their way towards Persia to find a warm place for the winter.883 Groups of two or three hundred quaggas, a type of wild ass, are sometimes seen migrating from the tropical plains of southern Africa to the area near the Malaleveen River. As they migrate, lions follow them, hunting and killing them night after night.884

The migratory swarms of the springbok, or Cape antelope, afford another illustration of the rapidity with which a species under certain circumstances may be diffused over a continent. When the stagnant pools of the immense deserts south of the Orange River dry up, which often happens after intervals of three or four years, myriads of these animals desert the parched soil, and pour down like a deluge on the cultivated regions near the Cape. The havoc committed by them resembles that of the African locusts; and so crowded are the herds, that "the lion has been seen to walk in the midst of the compressed phalanx with only as much room between him and his victims as the fears of those immediately around could procure by pressing outwards."885

The migratory swarms of springbok, or Cape antelope, are another example of how quickly a species can spread across a continent under certain conditions. When the stagnant pools in the vast deserts south of the Orange River dry up, which often happens every three to four years, countless animals leave the parched land and flood into the cultivated areas near the Cape. The destruction they cause is similar to that of African locusts; and the herds are so dense that "the lion has been seen to walk in the midst of the crowded group with only as much space between him and his prey as the fears of those around could create by pushing outward."885

Fig. 98. Mydaus meliceps, or badger-headed Mydaus. Length, including the tail, 16 inches.

Mydaus meliceps, or badger-headed Mydaus. Length, including the tail, 16 inches.

Mydaus meliceps, also known as the badger-headed Mydaus. Length, including the tail, is 16 inches.

Dr. Horsfield mentions a singular fact in regard to the geographical distribution of the Mydaus meliceps, an animal intermediate between the polecat and badger. It inhabits Java, and is "confined exclusively to those mountains which have an elevation of more than seven thousand feet above the level of the ocean; on these it occurs with the same regularity as many plants. The long extended surface of Java, abounding with conical points which exceed this elevation, affords many places favorable for its resort. On ascending these mountains, the traveller scarcely fails to meet with this animal, which, from its peculiarities, is universally known to the inhabitants of these elevated tracts, while to those of the plains it is as strange to an animal from a foreign county. In my visits to the mountainous districts, I uniformly met with it; and, as far as the information of the natives can be relied on, it is found on all the mountains."886

Dr. Horsfield points out an interesting fact about the geographic distribution of the Mydaus meliceps, an animal that is between a polecat and a badger. It lives in Java and is "found exclusively in the mountains that are over seven thousand feet above sea level; it appears there as regularly as many plants do. The vast landscape of Java, which has numerous peaks that are higher than this elevation, provides many spots where it can thrive. When climbing these mountains, travelers almost always encounter this animal, which, because of its unique features, is well-known to the locals in these high areas, while to those in the plains, it seems as foreign as an animal from another country. During my trips to the mountainous regions, I consistently came across it; and according to the reliable information from the locals, it can be found on all the mountains." 886

Now, if asked to conjecture how the Mydaus arrived at the elevated regions of each of these isolated mountains, we might say that, before the island was peopled by man, by whom their numbers are now thinned, they may occasionally have multiplied so as to be forced to collect together and migrate: in which case notwithstanding the slowness of their motions, some few would succeed in reaching another mountain, some twenty, or even, perhaps, fifty miles distant; for although the climate of the hot intervening plains would be unfavourable to them, they might support it for a time, and would find there abundance of insects on which they feed. Volcanic eruptions, which, at different times have covered the summits of some of those lofty cones with sterile sand and ashes, may have occasionally contributed to force on these migrations.

Now, if we were to guess how the Mydaus made it to the high regions of these isolated mountains, we might suggest that, before people inhabited the island—who have since reduced their numbers—they might have occasionally bred to the point where they had to gather together and move. In this scenario, despite their slow movements, a few would manage to reach another mountain, perhaps twenty or even fifty miles away; because, although the hot plains in between would be harsh for them, they could endure it for a time and would find plenty of insects to eat. Volcanic eruptions, which have at times covered the tops of some of those tall cones with barren sand and ash, may have also helped push these migrations along.

Drifting of animals on ice-floes.—The power of the terrestrial mammalia to cross the sea is very limited, and it was before stated that the same species is scarcely ever common to districts widely separated by the ocean. If there be some exceptions to this rule, they generally admit of explanation; for there are natural means whereby some animals may be floated across the water, and the sea may in the course of ages 640 wear a wide passage through a neck of land, leaving individuals of a species on each side of the new channel. Polar bears are known to have been frequently drifted on the ice from Greenland to Iceland; they can also swim to considerable distances, for Captain Parry, on the return of his ships through Barrow's Straits, met with a bear swimming in the water about midway between the shores, which were about forty miles apart, and where no ice was in sight.887 "Near the east coast of Greenland," observes Scoresby, "they have been seen on the ice in such quantities, that they were compared to flocks of sheep on a common; and they are often found on field-ice, above two hundred miles from the shore."888 Wolves, in the arctic regions, often venture upon the ice near the shore, for the purpose of preying upon young seals which they surprise when asleep. When these ice-floes get detached, the wolves are often carried out to sea; and though some may be drifted to islands or continents, the greater part of them perish, and have been often heard in this situation howling dreadfully, as they die by famine.889

Drifting of animals on ice floes.—The ability of land mammals to cross the sea is very limited, and it's been noted that the same species is rarely found in areas that are widely separated by the ocean. While there are some exceptions to this rule, they can usually be explained; there are natural ways for certain animals to get carried across the water, and over ages, the sea can carve out a wide passage through land, leaving individuals of a species on either side of the new channel. Polar bears are known to have frequently drifted on ice from Greenland to Iceland; they can also swim great distances. For instance, Captain Parry, on his ships' return through Barrow's Straits, encountered a bear swimming in the water about halfway between the shores, which were about forty miles apart, with no ice in sight.887 "Near the east coast of Greenland," Scoresby notes, "they have been seen on the ice in such large numbers that they were compared to flocks of sheep grazing in a field; and they are often found on field ice, more than two hundred miles from the shore."888 Wolves in the Arctic often venture onto the ice near the shore to hunt young seals they catch off guard while sleeping. When these ice floes break off, the wolves are often carried out to sea; although some may drift to islands or continents, most of them perish and have often been heard howling terribly in this situation as they die from starvation.889

During the short summer which visits Melville Island, various plants push forth their leaves and flowers the moment the snow is off the ground, and form a carpet spangled with the most lively colours. These secluded spots are reached annually by herds of musk-oxen and reindeer, which travel immense distances over dreary and desolate regions, to graze undisturbed on these luxuriant pastures.890 The rein-deer often pass along in the same manner, by the chain of the Aleutian Islands, from Behring's Straits to Kamtschatka, subsisting on the moss found in these islands during their passage.891 But the musk-ox, notwithstanding its migratory habits, and its long journeys over the ice, does not exist, either in Asia or Greenland.892

During the brief summer that comes to Melville Island, various plants burst forth with their leaves and flowers as soon as the snow melts, creating a vibrant carpet of color. Every year, herds of musk-oxen and reindeer travel vast distances across bleak and barren areas to graze undisturbed on these lush pastures.890 The reindeer often follow a similar route, moving through the chain of the Aleutian Islands from Bering Strait to Kamchatka, feeding on the moss found on these islands during their journey.891 However, the musk-ox, despite its migratory behavior and long journeys over the ice, does not exist in either Asia or Greenland.892

On floating islands of drift-wood.—Within the tropics there are no ice-floes; but, as if to compensate for that mode of transportation, there are floating islets of matted trees, which are often borne along through considerable spaces. These are sometimes seen sailing at the distance of fifty or one hundred miles from the mouth of the Ganges, with living trees standing erect upon them. The Amazon, the Congo, and the Orinoco, also produce these verdant rafts, which are formed in the manner already described when speaking of the great raft of the Atchafalaya, an arm of the Mississippi, where a natural bridge of timber, ten miles long, and more than two hundred yards wide, existed for more than forty years, supporting a luxuriant vegetation, and rising and sinking with the water which flowed beneath it.

On floating islands of driftwood.—In the tropics, there aren’t any ice floes; but to make up for that, there are floating islands of tangled trees that can often drift over long distances. Sometimes, they can be seen floating fifty to a hundred miles away from the mouth of the Ganges, with live trees standing tall on them. The Amazon, the Congo, and the Orinoco also create these green rafts, which form in the way previously described when discussing the huge raft in the Atchafalaya, a branch of the Mississippi, where a natural bridge of wood, ten miles long and more than two hundred yards wide, existed for over forty years, supporting lush vegetation and rising and falling with the water flowing underneath it.

On these green islets of the Mississippi, observes Malte-Brun, young trees take root, and the pistia and nenuphar display their yellow 641 flowers: serpents, birds, and the cayman alligator, come to repose there, and all are sometimes carried to the sea and engulphed in its waters.893

On these green islands of the Mississippi, Malte-Brun notes that young trees take root, and the pistia and water lilies show off their yellow flowers. Serpents, birds, and the caiman alligator come to rest there, and sometimes all of them are swept out to sea and swallowed by its waters.893

Spix and Martius relate that, during their travels in Brazil, they were exposed to great danger while ascending the Amazon in a canoe, from the vast quantity of drift-wood constantly propelled against them by the current; so much so, that their safety depended on the crew being always on the alert to turn aside the trunks of trees with long poles. The tops alone of some trees appeared above water, others had their roots attached to them with so much soil that they might be compared to floating islets. On these, say the travellers, we saw some very singular assemblages of animals, pursuing peacefully their uncertain way in strange companionship. On one raft were several grave-looking storks, perched by the side of a party of monkeys, who made comical gestures, and burst into loud cries, on seeing the canoe. On another was seen a number of ducks and divers, sitting by a group of squirrels. Next came down upon the stem of a large rotten cedar tree, an enormous crocodile, by the side of a tiger-cat, both animals regarding each other with hostility and mistrust, but the saurian being evidently most at his ease, as conscious of his superior strength.894

Spix and Martius report that, during their travels in Brazil, they faced great danger while paddling up the Amazon in a canoe due to the huge amounts of driftwood constantly pushing against them in the current. Their safety relied heavily on the crew being alert to steer away the tree trunks with long poles. Only the tops of some trees showed above the water, while others had their roots with so much soil that they resembled floating islands. The travelers observed some very unusual groupings of animals peacefully making their way together in this strange setting. On one raft, there were several serious-looking storks perched next to a group of monkeys that made funny faces and started loudly screeching when they saw the canoe. On another, there were ducks and divers sitting near a bunch of squirrels. Then, a massive crocodile came down a large rotting cedar tree and was spotted next to a tiger-cat, with both animals eyeing each other with hostility and distrust, though the crocodile seemed most at ease, knowing he had the upper hand in strength.894

Similar green rafts, principally composed of canes and brushwood, are called "camelotes" on the Parana in South America; and they are occasionally carried down by inundations, bearing on them the tiger, cayman, squirrels, and other quadrupeds, which are said to be always terror-stricken on their floating habitation. No less than four tigers (pumas) were landed in this manner in one night at Monte Video, lat. 35° S., to the great alarm of the inhabitants, who found them prowling about the streets in the morning.895

Similar green rafts, mostly made of reeds and brushwood, are called "camelotes" on the Paraná River in South America. They can sometimes be swept away by floods, carrying with them tigers, caimans, squirrels, and other mammals, which are said to be terrified on their floating home. One night in Montevideo, latitude 35° S., no fewer than four tigers (pumas) ended up on land this way, causing great alarm among the residents, who found them lurking in the streets the next morning.895

In a memoir lately published, a naval officer relates that, as he returned from China by the eastern passage, he fell in, among the Moluccas, with several small floating islands of this kind, covered with mangrove trees interwoven with underwood. The trees and shrubs retained their verdure, receiving nourishment from a stratum of soil which formed a white beach round the margin of each raft, where it was exposed to the washing of the waves and the rays of the sun.896 The occurrence of soil in such situations may easily be explained; for all the natural bridges of timber which occasionally connect the islands of the Ganges, Mississippi, and other rivers, with their banks, are exposed to floods of water, densely charged with sediment.

In a recently published memoir, a naval officer shares that as he was returning from China through the eastern route, he came across several small floating islands in the Moluccas. These islands were covered with mangrove trees intertwined with underbrush. The trees and shrubs stayed green, getting nourishment from a layer of soil that formed a white beach around the edges of each raft, where it was hit by waves and sunlight.896 The presence of soil in these locations makes sense; all the natural wooden bridges that sometimes connect the islands of the Ganges, Mississippi, and other rivers to their banks are exposed to floods of water heavily laden with sediment.

Captain W. H. Smyth informs me, that, when cruising in the Cornwallis amidst the Philippine Islands, he has more than once seen, after those dreadful hurricanes called typhoons, floating masses of wood, with 642 trees growing upon them, and ships have sometimes been in imminent peril, as often as these islands were mistaken for terra firma, when, in fact, they were in rapid motion.

Captain W. H. Smyth tells me that while cruising in the Cornwallis among the Philippine Islands, he has seen more than once, after those terrible hurricanes called typhoons, floating masses of wood with 642 trees growing on them. Ships have sometimes been in serious danger because these islands were often mistaken for solid ground, when in reality, they were moving quickly.

It is highly interesting to trace, in imagination, the effects of the passage of these rafts from the mouth of a large river to some archipelago, such as those in the South Pacific, raised from the deep, in comparatively modern times, by the operations of the volcano and the earthquake, and the joint labours of coral animals and testacea. If a storm arise, and the frail vessel be wrecked, still many a bird and insect may succeed in gaining, by flight, some island of the newly formed group, while the seeds and berries of herbs and shrubs, which fall into the waves, may be thrown upon the strand. But if the surface of the deep be calm, and the rafts are carried along by a current, or wafted by some slight breath of air fanning the foliage of the green trees, it may arrive, after a passage of several weeks, at the bay of an island, into which its plants and animals may be poured out as from an ark, and thus a colony of several hundred new species may at once be naturalized.

It's really fascinating to imagine the journey of these rafts from the mouth of a large river to an archipelago, like those in the South Pacific, which were formed relatively recently by volcanic activity, earthquakes, and the combined efforts of coral and shellfish. If a storm hits and the fragile vessel is destroyed, many birds and insects might still manage to fly to some of the newly formed islands, while seeds and berries from plants could be washed ashore by the waves. However, if the ocean is calm and the rafts are carried along by a current or a gentle breeze rustling the leaves of the green trees, it may eventually reach an island's bay, where the plants and animals spill out like from an ark, allowing a colony of several hundred new species to become established all at once.

The reader should be reminded, that I merely advert to the transportation of these rafts as of extremely rare and accidental occurrence; but it may account, in tropical countries, for some of the rare exceptions to the general law of the confined range of mammiferous species.

The reader should remember that I only mention the transportation of these rafts as something that happens very rarely and by chance; however, it might explain some of the unusual cases in tropical countries where there are exceptions to the general rule about the limited distribution of mammal species.

Migrations of the Cetacea.—Many of the Cetacea, the whales of the northern seas for example, are found to desert one tract of the sea, and to visit another very distant, when they are urged by want of food, or danger. The seals also retire from the coast of Greenland in July, return again in September, and depart again in March, to return in June. They proceed in great droves northwards, directing their course where the sea is most free from ice, and are observed to be extremely fat when they set out on this expedition, and very lean when they come home again.897

Migrations of the Cetacea.—Many cetaceans, like the whales in the northern seas, are known to leave one area of the ocean and travel to another distant location when they are in search of food or trying to escape danger. Similarly, seals move away from the coast of Greenland in July, return in September, and leave again in March, coming back in June. They travel in large groups northward, heading towards areas of the sea that are mostly free of ice, and they are seen to be quite fat when they start this journey, but very lean by the time they return home again.897

Species of the Mediterranean, Black Sea, and Caspian identical.—Some naturalists have wondered that the sea-calves, dolphins, and other marine mammalia of the Mediterranean and Black Sea, should be identical with those found in the Caspian: and among other fanciful theories, they have suggested that they may dive through subterranean conduits, and thus pass from one sea into the other. But as the occurrence of wolves and other noxious animals, on both sides of the British Channel, was adduced, by Verstegan and Desmarest, as one of many arguments to prove that England and France were once united; so the correspondence of the aquatic species of the inland seas of Asia with those of the Black Sea tend to confirm the hypothesis, for which there are abundance of independent geological data, that those seas were connected together by straits at no remote period of the earth's history.

Species of the Mediterranean, Black Sea, and Caspian identical.—Some naturalists have been puzzled that the seals, dolphins, and other marine mammals from the Mediterranean and Black Sea are the same as those found in the Caspian Sea. Among various imaginative theories, they have proposed that these animals might dive through underground channels and travel from one sea to another. However, just as Verstegan and Desmarest used the presence of wolves and other harmful animals on both sides of the English Channel to argue that England and France were once connected, the similarity of aquatic species in the inland seas of Asia with those in the Black Sea supports the idea—backed by plenty of independent geological evidence—that these seas were linked by straits not too long ago in Earth's history.

Geographical Distribution and Migrations of Birds.

I shall now offer a few observations on some of the other divisions of 643 the animal kingdom. Birds, notwithstanding their great locomotive powers, form no exception to the general rules already laid down; but, in this class, as in plants and terrestrial quadrupeds, different groups of species are circumscribed within definite limits. We find, for example, one assemblage in the Brazils, another in the same latitudes in Central Africa, another in India, and a fourth in New Holland. Of twenty-six different species of land birds found in the Galapagos archipelago, all, with the exception of one, are distinct from those inhabiting other parts of the globe;898 and in other archipelagos a single island sometimes contains a species found in no other spot on the whole earth; as is exemplified in some of the parrot tribes. In this extensive family, which are, with few exceptions, inhabitants of tropical regions, the American group has not one in common with the African, nor either of these with the parrots of India.899

I’m going to share some thoughts on other parts of the643 animal kingdom. Birds, despite their incredible ability to move around, still follow the general rules we’ve discussed; however, in this category, just like with plants and land mammals, various groups of species are confined to specific boundaries. For instance, we have one group in Brazil, another in similar areas of Central Africa, one in India, and a fourth in Australia. Out of twenty-six different species of land birds found in the Galapagos Islands, all except one are unique compared to those in other regions of the world;898 and in other archipelagos, a single island can sometimes host a species that’s not found anywhere else on the planet, as seen in certain parrot species. In this large family, which primarily consists of species in tropical areas, the American group has no overlap with the African group, nor do either of these share any species with the parrots of India.899

Another illustration is afforded by that minute and beautiful tribe, the humming-birds. The whole of them are, in the first place, peculiar to the new world; but some species are confined to Mexico, while others exist only in some of the West India Islands, and have not been found elsewhere in the western hemisphere. Yet there are species of this family which have a vast range, as the Trochilus flammifrons (or Mellisuga Kingii), which is found over a space of 2500 miles on the west coast of South America, from the hot dry country of Lima to the humid forests of Tierra del Fuego. Captain King, during his survey in the years 1826-30, found this bird at the Straits of Magellan, in the month of May—the depth of winter—sucking the flowers of a large species of fuchsia, then in bloom, in the midst of a shower of snow.

Another example is seen in the tiny and stunning tribe of hummingbirds. All of them are, first of all, unique to the New World; some species are only found in Mexico, while others exist only on certain Caribbean islands and haven't been located anywhere else in the Western Hemisphere. However, there are species in this family that have a wide range, like the Trochilus flammifrons (or Mellisuga Kingii), which spans over 2,500 miles along the west coast of South America, from the hot, dry regions of Lima to the humid forests of Tierra del Fuego. Captain King, during his survey from 1826 to 1830, discovered this bird at the Straits of Magellan in May—the height of winter—feeding on the flowers of a large fuchsia species that was blooming amidst a snowfall.

The ornithology of our own country affords one well-known and striking exemplification of the law of a limited specific range; for the common grouse (Tetra scoticus) occurs nowhere in the known world except in the British isles.

The birdlife in our country provides a well-known and striking example of the law of limited specific range; the common grouse (Tetra scoticus) is found nowhere else in the world except in the British Isles.

Some species of the vulture tribe are said to be cosmopolites; and the common wild goose (Anas anser, Linn.), if we may believe some ornithologists, is a general inhabitant of the globe, being met with from Lapland to the Cape of Good Hope, frequent in Arabia, Persia, China, and Japan, and in the American continent from Hudson's Bay to South Carolina.900 An extraordinary range has also been attributed to the nightingale, which extends from western Europe to Persia, and still farther. In a work entitled Specchio Comparativo,901 by Charles Bonaparte, many species of birds are enumerated as common to Rome and Philadelphia: the greater part of these are migratory, but some of them, such as the long-eared owl (Strix otus), are permanent in both countries. The correspondence of the ornithological fauna of the eastern and 644 western hemispheres increases considerably, as might have been anticipated, in high northern latitudes.902

Some types of vultures are considered to be found all over the world; and the common wild goose (Anas anser, Linn.) is, according to some ornithologists, a global inhabitant. It's encountered from Lapland to the Cape of Good Hope, often seen in Arabia, Persia, China, and Japan, and across North America from Hudson's Bay to South Carolina.900 An incredible range is also noted for the nightingale, which stretches from western Europe to Persia and beyond. In a work titled Specchio Comparativo,901 authored by Charles Bonaparte, many bird species are listed as common to both Rome and Philadelphia: most of these are migratory, but some, like the long-eared owl (Strix otus), are permanent residents in both countries. The similarities in the bird species of the eastern and western hemispheres notably increase, as expected, in high northern latitudes.902

Their facilities of diffusion.—In parallel zones of the northern and southern hemispheres, a great general correspondence of form is observable, both in the aquatic and terrestrial birds; but there is rarely any specific identity; and this phenomenon is truly remarkable, when we recollect the readiness with which some birds, not gifted with great powers of flight, shift their quarters to different regions, and the facility with which others, possessing great strength of wing, perform their aërial voyage. Some migrate periodically from high latitudes, to avoid the cold of winter, and the accompaniments of cold,—scarcity of insects and vegetable food; others, it is said, for some particular kinds of nutriment required for rearing their young: for this purpose they often traverse the ocean for thousands of miles, and recross it at other periods, with equal security.

Their ability to spread.—In similar areas of the northern and southern hemispheres, there is a noticeable overall similarity in shape among both aquatic and land birds; however, there's rarely any specific match. This is particularly striking when we consider how easily some birds, which don’t have strong flying abilities, move to different places, and how effortlessly others, with powerful wings, complete their long flights. Some birds migrate regularly from colder regions to escape winter’s chill and the lack of insects and plant food that comes with it; others, it is said, do so for specific types of food needed to raise their young. To find this food, they often travel across oceans for thousands of miles and return at different times with the same ease.

Periodical migrations, no less regular, are mentioned by Humboldt, of many American water-fowl, from one part of the tropics to another, in a zone where there is the same temperature throughout the year. Immense flights of ducks leave the valley of the Orinoco, when the increasing depth of its waters and the flooding of its shores prevent them from catching fish, insects, and aquatic worms. They then betake themselves to the Rio Negro and Amazon, having passed from the eighth and third degrees of north latitude to the first and fourth of south latitude, directing their course south-south-east. In September, when the Orinoco decreases and re-enters its channel, these birds return northwards.903

Regular migrations are also noted by Humboldt, involving many American waterfowl moving from one part of the tropics to another in a region with a consistent temperature year-round. Huge flocks of ducks leave the Orinoco Valley when the rising waters and flooding shores make it hard for them to find fish, insects, and aquatic worms. They then head to the Rio Negro and Amazon, traveling from the eighth and third degrees north latitude to the first and fourth degrees south latitude, moving in a south-south-east direction. In September, when the Orinoco recedes and returns to its channel, these birds fly back north.903

The insectivorous swallows which visit our island would perish during winter, if they did not annually repair to warmer climes. It is supposed that in these aerial excursions the average rapidity of their flight is not less than fifty miles an hour; so that, when aided by the wind, they soon reach warmer latitudes. Spallanzani calculated that the swallow can fly at the rate of ninety-two miles an hour, and conceived that the rapidity of the swift might be three times greater.904 The rate of flight of the eider duck (Anas mollissima) is said to be ninety miles an hour; and Bachman says that the hawk, wild pigeon (Columba migratoria), and several species of wild ducks, in North America, fly at the rate of forty miles an hour, or nearly a thousand miles in twenty-four hours.905

The insect-eating swallows that come to our island would die in winter if they didn't migrate to warmer places each year. It's estimated that during these flights, they average about fifty miles an hour; with the wind at their back, they quickly reach warmer areas. Spallanzani calculated that swallows can fly at speeds of ninety-two miles an hour, and he thought the swift could fly three times faster.904 The eider duck (Anas mollissima) is said to fly at ninety miles an hour; and Bachman notes that hawks, wild pigeons (Columba migratoria), and several types of wild ducks in North America can fly at about forty miles an hour, which adds up to nearly a thousand miles in a day.905

When we reflect how easily different species, in a great lapse of ages, may be each overtaken by gales and hurricanes, and, abandoning themselves to the tempest, be scattered at random through various regions of the earth's surface, where the temperature of the atmosphere, the vegetation, and the animal productions, might be suited to their wants, we shall be prepared to find some species capriciously distributed, and 645 to be sometimes unable to determine the native countries of each. Captain Smyth informs me, that, when engaged in his survey of the Mediterranean, he encountered a gale in the Gulf of Lyons, at the distance of between twenty and thirty leagues from the coast of France, which bore along many land birds of various species, some of which alighted on the ship, while others were thrown with violence against the sails. In this manner islands become tenanted by species of birds inhabiting the nearest mainland.

When we think about how easily different species can be swept away by storms and hurricanes over a long period of time, and how they might throw themselves into the storm and get scattered randomly across different parts of the earth, where the climate, plants, and animals might meet their needs, we can expect to find some species appearing in odd places. This might make it hard to determine their native countries. Captain Smyth told me that while he was surveying the Mediterranean, he came across a storm in the Gulf of Lyons, about twenty to thirty leagues from the French coast, that carried many land birds of different species. Some landed on the ship, while others were forcefully tossed against the sails. This is how islands can end up being populated by bird species from the nearest mainland.

Geographical Distribution and Dissemination of Reptiles.

A few facts respecting the third great class of vertebrated animals will suffice to show that the plan of nature in regard to their location on the globe is perfectly analogous to that already exemplified in other parts of the organic creation, and has probably been determined by similar causes.

A few facts about the third major group of vertebrate animals will be enough to demonstrate that nature's design concerning their distribution around the world is completely similar to what we've already seen in other areas of the living world, and it has likely been influenced by comparable factors.

Habitations of reptiles.—Of the great saurians, the gavials which inhabit the Ganges differ from the cayman of America, or the crocodile of the Nile. The monitor of New Holland is specifically distinct from the Indian species; these latter, again, from the African, and all from their congeners in the new world. So in regard to snakes; we find the boa of America represented by the python, a different though nearly allied genus in India. America is the country of the rattlesnake; Africa, of the cerastes; and Asia, of the hooded snake, or cobra di capello. The amphibious genera Siren and Menopoma belong to North America, possessing both lungs and gills, and respiring at pleasure either air or water. The only analogous animal of the old world is the Proteus anguinus of the lakes of Lower Carniola, and the grotto of Adelsberg between Trieste and Vienna.906

Habitations of reptiles.—Among the large lizards, the gavials living in the Ganges are different from the caimans in America and the crocodiles in the Nile. The monitor lizard from New Holland is distinct from the Indian species; and those, in turn, are different from the African ones, which are all separate from their relatives in the New World. The same goes for snakes; the American boa is represented by the python, a different but closely related genus found in India. America is home to the rattlesnake; Africa has the cerastes; and Asia is known for the hooded snake, or cobra di cappello. The amphibious genera Siren and Menopoma are found in North America, having both lungs and gills, allowing them to breathe air or water as they choose. The only similar animal in the Old World is the Proteus anguinus, which inhabits the lakes of Lower Carniola and the Adelsberg caves between Trieste and Vienna.906

There is a legend that St. Patrick expelled all reptiles from Ireland; and certain it is that none of the three species of snakes common in England, nor the toad, have been observed there by naturalists. They have our common frog, and our water-newt, and according to Ray (Quad. 264.), the green lizard (Lacerta viridis).

There’s a legend that St. Patrick drove all the snakes out of Ireland; and it’s true that none of the three types of snakes found in England, nor the toad, have been seen there by naturalists. They do have our common frog and our water-newt, and according to Ray (Quad. 264.), the green lizard (Lacerta viridis).

Migrations of the larger reptiles.—The range of the large reptiles is, in general, quite as limited as that of some orders of the terrestrial mammalia. The great saurians sometimes cross a considerable tract in order to pass from one river to another; but their motions by land are generally slower than those of quadrupeds. By water, however, they may transport themselves to distant situations more easily. The larger alligator of the Ganges sometimes descends beyond the brackish water of the delta into the sea; and in such cases it might chance to be drifted away by a current, and survive till it reached a shore at some distance; but such casualties are probably very rare.

Migrations of the larger reptiles.—The range of large reptiles is generally just as limited as that of some groups of land mammals. The big lizards sometimes travel across a considerable distance to move from one river to another, but their movement on land is usually slower than that of four-legged animals. However, they can move more easily to distant locations by water. The larger alligators of the Ganges occasionally venture beyond the brackish waters of the delta and into the sea; in such cases, they might get carried away by a current and survive until they reach a distant shore, but such events are probably very rare.

Turtles migrate in large droves from one part of the ocean to another 646 during the ovipositing season; and they find their way annually to the island of Ascension, from which the nearest land is about 800 miles distant. Dr. Fleming mentions, that an individual of the hawk's bill turtle (Chelonia imbricata), so common in the American seas, has been taken at Papa Stour, one of the West Zetland Islands;907 and, according to Sibbald, "the same animal came into Orkney." Another was taken, in 1774, in the Severn, according to Turton. Two instances, also, of the occurrence of the leathern tortoise (C. coriacea), on the coast of Cornwall, in 1756, are mentioned by Borlase. These animals of more southern seas can be considered only as stragglers, attracted to our shores during uncommonly warm seasons by an abundant supply of food, or carried by the Gulf stream, or driven by storms to high latitudes.

Turtles travel in large groups from one part of the ocean to another 646 during the egg-laying season; they return each year to Ascension Island, which is about 800 miles from the nearest land. Dr. Fleming notes that a hawk's bill turtle (Chelonia imbricata), common in American waters, was found at Papa Stour, one of the West Zetland Islands;907 and, according to Sibbald, "the same turtle was spotted in Orkney." Another was caught in 1774 in the Severn, as reported by Turton. Borlase also mentions two sightings of the leatherback turtle (C. coriacea) along the coast of Cornwall in 1756. These creatures from warmer seas are usually just stragglers that come to our shores during unusually warm seasons due to an abundance of food, or they might be carried by the Gulf Stream, or pushed by storms to higher latitudes.

Some of the smaller reptiles lay their eggs on aquatic plants; and these must often be borne rapidly by rivers, and conveyed to distant regions in a manner similar to the dispersion of seeds before adverted to. But that the larger ophidians may be themselves transported across the seas, is evident from the following most interesting account of the arrival of one at the island of St. Vincent. It is worthy of being recorded, says Mr. Guilding, "that a noble specimen of the Boa constrictor was lately conveyed to us by the currents, twisted round the trunk of a large sound cedar tree, which had probably been washed out of the bank by the floods of some great South American river, while its huge folds hung on the branches, as it waited for its prey. The monster was fortunately destroyed after killing a few sheep, and his skeleton now hangs before me in my study, putting me in mind how much reason I might have had to fear in my future rambles through the forests of St. Vincent, had this formidable reptile been a pregnant female, and escaped to a safe retreat."908

Some of the smaller reptiles lay their eggs on aquatic plants, and these are often carried away quickly by rivers, spreading to distant areas similar to how seeds disperse. However, it's clear that larger snakes can also be transported across the seas, as shown by a fascinating account of one arriving at the island of St. Vincent. Mr. Guilding notes, "A remarkable specimen of the Boa constrictor was recently brought to us by the currents, coiled around the trunk of a large, healthy cedar tree that likely got washed out of the bank by the floods of some major South American river, while its massive body hung on the branches, waiting for its prey. Luckily, the creature was killed after it had already taken a few sheep, and its skeleton is now displayed in my study, reminding me how much I could have feared during my future walks in the forests of St. Vincent if this dangerous snake had been a pregnant female and managed to escape to safety."908


CHAPTER XXXIX.

LAWS WHICH REGULATE THE GEOGRAPHICAL DISTRIBUTION OF SPECIES—continued.

Geographical distribution and migration of Fish—of Testaoea—of Zoophytes—Distribution of Insects—Migratory instincts of some species—Certain types characterize particular countries—Their means of dissemination—Geographical distribution and diffusion of man—Speculations as to the birth-place of the human species—Progress of human population—Drifting of canoes to vast distances—On the involuntary influence of man in extending the range of many other species.

Geographical distribution and migration of fish—of Testaoea—of zoophytes—Distribution of insects—Migratory instincts of some species—Certain types are characteristic of specific countries—Their means of spread—Geographical distribution and diffusion of humans—Speculations about the birthplace of the human species—Growth of the human population—Drifting of canoes over great distances—On the unintentional impact of humans in expanding the range of many other species.

Geographical Distribution and Migrations of Fish.

Although we are less acquainted with the habitations of marine animals than with the grouping of the terrestrial species before described, yet it 647 is well ascertained that their distribution is governed by the same general laws. The testimony borne by MM. Péron and Lesueur to this important fact is remarkably strong. These eminent naturalists, after collecting and describing many thousand species of marine animals which they brought to Europe from the southern hemisphere, insist most emphatically on their distinctness from those north of the equator; and this remark they extend to animals of all classes, from those of a more simple to those of a more complex organization—from the sponges and Medusæ to the Cetacea. "Among all those which we have been able to examine," say they, "with our own eyes, or with regard to which it has appeared to us possible to pronounce with certainty, there is not a single animal of the southern regions which is not distinguished by essential characters from the analogous species in the northern seas."909

Although we know less about where marine animals live compared to the groups of land species described earlier, it’s clear that their distribution follows the same general rules. The evidence provided by MM. Péron and Lesueur on this crucial fact is particularly strong. These notable naturalists, after gathering and describing numerous marine species they brought to Europe from the southern hemisphere, strongly emphasize their differences from those north of the equator. They make this observation about animals across all categories, from simpler forms like sponges and jellyfish to more complex ones like whales. "Among all those we have examined," they state, "either ourselves or based on reliable information, there is not a single marine animal from the southern regions that does not have distinct characteristics compared to similar species in the northern seas."

On comparing the freshwater fish of Europe and North America, Sir John Richardson remarks, that the only species which is unequivocally common to the two continents is the pike (Esox lucius); and it is curious that this fish is unknown to the westward of the Rocky Mountains, the very coast which approaches nearest to the old continent.910 According to the same author the genera of freshwater fish in China agree closely with those of the peninsula of India, but the species are not the same. "As in the distribution," he adds, "of marine fish, the interposition of a continent stretching from the tropics far into the temperate or colder parts of the ocean, separate different ichthyological groups; so with respect to the freshwater species, the intrusion of arms of the sea running far to the northwards, or the interposition of a lofty mountain-chain, effects the same thing. The freshwater fish of the Cape of Good Hope and the South American ones, are different from those of India and China, &c."911

When comparing the freshwater fish of Europe and North America, Sir John Richardson notes that the only species that is definitely common to both continents is the pike (Esox lucius); it's interesting that this fish is not found west of the Rocky Mountains, the coast that is closest to the old continent.910 According to the same author, the genera of freshwater fish in China closely resemble those in the Indian peninsula, but the species are different. "Just as with marine fish distribution," he adds, "the presence of a continent stretching from the tropics into the temperate or colder parts of the ocean separates different fish groups; the same applies to freshwater species, where the intrusion of sea inlets extending far northward or the presence of a high mountain range has the same effect. The freshwater fish of the Cape of Good Hope and those in South America are different from those in India and China, etc."911

Cuvier and Valenciennes, in their "Histoire des Poissons," observe, that very few species of fish cross the Atlantic. Although their statement is correct, it is found that a great many species are common to the opposite sides of the Indian Ocean, inhabiting alike the Red Sea, the eastern coast of Africa, Madagascar, the Mauritius, the Indian Ocean, the southern seas of China, the Malay archipelago, the northern coasts of Australia, and the whole of Polynesia!912 This very wide diffusion, says Sir J. Richardson, may have been promoted by chains of islands running east and west, which are wanting in the deep Atlantic. An archipelago extending far in longitude, favours the migration of fish by multiplying the places of deposit for spawn along the shores of islands, and on intervening coral banks; and in such places, also, fish find their appropriate food.

Cuvier and Valenciennes, in their "Histoire des Poissons," note that very few fish species cross the Atlantic. While their statement is true, many species are actually found on both sides of the Indian Ocean, living in the Red Sea, the eastern coast of Africa, Madagascar, Mauritius, the Indian Ocean, the southern seas of China, the Malay archipelago, the northern shores of Australia, and throughout Polynesia!912 Sir J. Richardson suggests that this extensive distribution may have been encouraged by chains of islands running east and west, which are absent in the deep Atlantic. An archipelago stretching far in longitude helps fish migrate by providing multiple spawning sites along the shores of islands and on the coral banks in between; these locations also offer fish the right kind of food.

The flying fish are found (some stragglers excepted) only between the tropics: in receding from the line, they never approach a higher latitude 648 than the fortieth parallel. The course of the Gulf stream, however, and the warmth of its water, enable some tropical fish to extend their habitations far into the temperate zone; thus the chætodons which abound in the seas of hot climates, are found among the Bermudas on the thirty-second parallel, where they are preserved in basins inclosed from the sea, as an important article of food for the garrison and inhabitants. Other fish, following the direction of the same great current, range from the coast of Brazil to the banks of Newfoundland.913

Flying fish are mostly found (with some exceptions) only between the tropics. As they move away from the equator, they never get closer to a higher latitude than the fortieth parallel. However, the Gulf Stream and its warm waters allow some tropical fish to live much further into the temperate zone. For instance, the chætodons that thrive in warm seas are also found around Bermuda at the thirty-second parallel, where they’re kept in enclosed basins from the ocean as a key food source for the garrison and local residents. Other fish, following the same major current, travel from the coast of Brazil all the way to the banks of Newfoundland.648913

All are aware that there are certain fish of passage which have their periodical migrations, like some tribes of birds. The salmon, towards the season of spawning, ascends the rivers for hundreds of miles, leaping up the cataracts which it meets in its course, and then retreats again into the depths of the ocean. The herring and the haddock, after frequenting certain shores, in vast shoals, for a series of years, desert them again, and resort to other stations, followed by the species which prey on them. Eels are said to descend into the sea for the purpose of producing their young, which are seen returning into the fresh water by myriads, extremely small in size, but possessing the power of surmounting every obstacle which occurs in the course of a river, by applying their slimy and glutinous bodies to the surface of rocks, or the gates of a lock, even when dry, and so climbing over it.914 Before the year 1800 there were no eels in Lake Wener, the largest inland lake in Sweden, which discharges its waters by the celebrated cataracts of Trolhättan. But I am informed by Professor Nilsson, that since the canal was opened uniting the river Gotha with the lake by a series of nine locks, each of great height, eels have been observed in abundance in the lake. It appears, therefore, that though they were unable to ascend the falls, they have made their way by the locks, by which in a very short space a difference of level of 114 feet is overcome.

Everyone knows that there are certain fish that migrate regularly, much like some bird species. The salmon, during spawning season, swims upstream for hundreds of miles, jumping over the waterfalls it encounters along the way, and then returns to the depths of the ocean. The herring and haddock, after spending many years along certain shores in large schools, leave those areas and move to other locations, followed by the predators that hunt them. Eels are said to swim down to the sea to spawn, and then they return to freshwater in huge numbers, tiny in size, but capable of overcoming every obstacle in a river by using their slimy, slippery bodies to glide over rocks or the gates of a lock, even when dry, and climb over them.914 Before 1800, there were no eels in Lake Wener, the largest inland lake in Sweden, which drains through the famous waterfalls of Trolhättan. However, I’ve been informed by Professor Nilsson that since the canal was opened, connecting the river Gotha with the lake through a series of nine high locks, eels have been seen in large numbers in the lake. It appears that, although they were unable to scale the falls, they have successfully navigated the locks, overcoming a level difference of 114 feet in a very short time.

Gmelin says, that the Anseres (wild geese, ducks, and others) subsist, in their migrations, on the spawn of fish; and that oftentimes, when they void the spawn, two or three days afterwards, the eggs retain their vitality unimpaired.915 When there are many disconnected freshwater lakes in a mountainous region, at various elevations, each remote from the other, it has often been deemed inconceivable how they could all become stocked with fish from one common source; but it has been suggested, that the minute eggs of these animals may sometimes be entangled in the feathers of water-fowl. These, when they alight to wash and plume themselves in the water, may often unconsciously contribute to propagate swarms of fish, which, in due season, will supply them with food. Some of the water-beetles, also, as the Dyticidæ, are amphibious, and in the evening quit their lakes and pools, and, flying in the air, transport the minute ova of fishes to distant waters. In this manner some naturalists account for the fry of fish appearing occasionally 649 in small pools caused by heavy rains; but the showers of small fish, stated in so many accounts to have fallen from the atmosphere, require farther investigation.

Gmelin mentions that wild geese, ducks, and other waterfowl rely on fish spawn during their migrations. Often, when they excrete the spawn a few days later, the eggs still maintain their vitality. 915 It’s often considered unbelievable how numerous isolated freshwater lakes in a mountainous area, at different heights, could all be populated with fish from a single source. However, some suggest that tiny fish eggs can sometimes get caught in the feathers of waterfowl. When these birds land to clean themselves in the water, they might unintentionally help spread fish populations, which will later provide them with food. Additionally, some water beetles, like the Dyticidæ, are amphibious and, in the evening, leave their lakes and pools to fly through the air, bringing tiny fish eggs to distant waters. This is how some naturalists explain the occasional appearance of fish fry in small pools formed by heavy rains; however, the reports of small fish seemingly falling from the sky need further investigation. 649

Geographical Distribution and Migrations of Testacea.

The Testacea, of which so great a variety of species occurs in the sea, are a class of animals of peculiar importance to the geologist; because their remains are found in strata of all ages, and generally in a higher state of preservation than those of other organic beings. Climate has a decided influence on the geographical distribution of species in this class; but as there is much greater uniformity of temperature in the waters of the ocean, than in the atmosphere which invests the land, the diffusion of marine mollusks is on the whole more extensive.

The Testacea, which include a wide variety of species found in the sea, are a group of animals that are particularly important to geologists. This is because their remains are found in rock layers from all ages and are generally better preserved than those of other living organisms. Climate significantly affects the geographical distribution of species in this group; however, since ocean waters have much more consistent temperatures than the atmosphere over land, marine mollusks are generally more widely distributed.

Some forms attain their fullest development in warm latitudes; and are often exclusively confined to the torrid zone, as Nautilus, Harpa, Terebellum, Pyramidella, Delphinula, Aspergillum, Tridacna, Cucullæa, Crassatella, Corbis, Perna, and Plicatula. Other forms are limited to one region of the sea, as the Trigonia to parts of Australia, and the Concholepas to the western coast of South America. The marine species inhabiting the ocean on the opposite sides of the narrow isthmus of Panama, are found to differ almost entirely, as we might have anticipated, since a West Indian mollusk cannot enter the Pacific without coasting round South America, and passing through the inclement climate of Cape Horn. The continuity of the existing lines of continent from north to south, prevents any one species from belting the globe, or from following the direction of the isothermal lines.

Some species reach their full development in warm regions and are often found only in the tropics, such as Nautilus, Harpa, Terebellum, Pyramidella, Delphinula, Aspergillum, Tridacna, Cucullæa, Crassatella, Corbis, Perna, and Plicatula. Other species are confined to specific areas of the ocean, like Trigonia, which is found in parts of Australia, and Concholepas, which lives on the western coast of South America. The marine species on either side of the narrow isthmus of Panama differ almost completely, as we might expect, since a West Indian mollusk can't enter the Pacific without navigating around South America and enduring the harsh conditions of Cape Horn. The unbroken landmasses extending from north to south make it impossible for any single species to circle the globe or follow the path of isothermal lines.

Currents also flowing permanently in certain directions, and the influx at certain points of great bodies of fresh water, limit the extension of many species. Those which love deep water are arrested by shoals; others, fitted for shallow seas, cannot migrate across unfathomable abysses. The nature also of the ground has an important influence on the testaceous fauna, both on the land and beneath the waters. Certain species prefer a sandy, others a gravelly, and some a muddy sea-bottom. On the land, limestone is of all rocks the most favourable to the number and propagation of species of the genera Helix, Clausilia, Bulimus, and others. Professor E. Forbes has shown as the result of his labours in dredging in the Ægean Sea, that there are eight well-marked regions of depth, each characterized by its peculiar testaceous fauna. The first of these, called the littoral zone, extends to a depth of two fathoms only; but this narrow belt is inhabited by more than one hundred species. The second region, of which ten fathoms is the inferior limit, is almost equally populous; and a copious list of species is given as characteristic of each region down to the seventh, which lies between the depths of 80 and 105 fathoms, all the inhabited space below this being included in the eighth province, where no less than 65 species of Testacea have been taken. The majority of the shells in this lowest zone are white or 650 transparent. Only two species of Mollusca are common to all the eight regions, namely, Arca lactea and Cerithium lima.916

Currents constantly flow in certain directions, and the influx of large amounts of fresh water at specific points restricts the range of many species. Those that thrive in deep water are stopped by shallow areas; others, suited for shallow seas, can't move across immeasurable depths. The type of ground also significantly affects the shellfish species, both on land and in water. Some species prefer sandy bottoms, others like gravelly ones, and some thrive in muddy seabeds. On land, limestone is the best rock for the growth and reproduction of species from the genera Helix, Clausilia, Bulimus, and others. Professor E. Forbes demonstrated through his dredging work in the Aegean Sea that there are eight distinct depth regions, each with its own unique shellfish fauna. The first, known as the littoral zone, extends to a depth of only two fathoms; however, this narrow band is home to more than one hundred species. The second region, with a minimum depth of ten fathoms, is similarly rich in species, and a detailed list of species is provided for each region down to the seventh, which lies between 80 and 105 fathoms deep, with all the space below that classified in the eighth province, where at least 65 species of shellfish have been found. Most shells in this lowest zone are white or transparent. Only two species of Mollusca are found in all eight regions, specifically Arca lactea and Cerithium lima.916

Great range of some provinces and species.—In Europe conchologists distinguish between the arctic fauna, the southern boundary of which corresponds with the isothermal line of 32° F., and the Celtic, which, commencing with that limit as its northern frontier, extends southwards to the mouth of the English Channel and Cape Finisterre, in France. From that point begins the Lusitanian fauna, which, according to the recent observations of Mr. M'Andrew (1852), ranges to the Canary Islands. The Mediterranean province is distinct from all those above enumerated, although it has some species in common with each.

Great range of some provinces and species.—In Europe, shell collectors distinguish between the arctic fauna, which has its southern boundary at the isothermal line of 32° F., and the Celtic fauna, which starts at that limit as its northern edge and extends south to the mouth of the English Channel and Cape Finisterre in France. From there, the Lusitanian fauna begins, which, according to recent observations by Mr. M'Andrew (1852), extends to the Canary Islands. The Mediterranean region is distinct from all the ones mentioned above, although it shares some species with each.

The Indo-Pacific region is by far the most extensive of all. It reaches from the Red Sea and the eastern coast of Africa, to the Indian Archipelago, and adjoining parts of the Pacific Ocean. To the geologist it furnishes a fact of no small interest, by teaching us that one group of living species of mollusca may prevail throughout an area exceeding in magnitude the utmost limits we can as yet assign to any assemblage of contemporaneous fossil species. Mr. Cuming obtained more than a hundred species of shells from the eastern coast of Africa identical with those collected by himself at the Philippines and in the eastern coral islands of the Pacific Ocean, a distance equal to that from pole to pole.917

The Indo-Pacific region is by far the largest of all. It stretches from the Red Sea and the eastern coast of Africa to the Indian Archipelago and nearby parts of the Pacific Ocean. For geologists, it's quite fascinating because it shows us that one group of living mollusk species can be found across an area that is larger than any we have defined for contemporary fossil species. Mr. Cuming collected over a hundred species of shells from the eastern coast of Africa that are identical to those he found in the Philippines and in the eastern coral islands of the Pacific Ocean, a distance comparable to that from pole to pole.917

Certain species of the genus Ianthina have a very wide range, being common to seas north and south of the equator. They are all provided with a beautifully contrived float, which renders them buoyant, facilitating their dispersion, and enabling them to become active agents in disseminating other species. Captain King took a specimen of Ianthina fragilis, alive, a little north of the equator, so loaded with barnacles (Pentelasmis) and their ova that the upper part of its shell was invisible. The "Rock Whelk" (Purpura lapillus), a well-known British univalve, inhabits both the North Atlantic and North Pacific.

Certain species of the genus Ianthina have a very wide range, being common in seas both north and south of the equator. They all have a beautifully designed float that makes them buoyant, helping them spread out and enabling them to play an active role in distributing other species. Captain King collected a living specimen of Ianthina fragilis just north of the equator, so covered in barnacles (Pentelasmis) and their eggs that the top part of its shell was invisible. The "Rock Whelk" (Purpura lapillus), a well-known British univalve, is found in both the North Atlantic and North Pacific.

Helix putris (Succinea putris, Lam.), so common in Europe, where it reaches from Norway to Italy, is also said to occur in the United States and in Newfoundland. As this animal inhabits constantly the borders of pools and streams where there is much moisture, it is not impossible that different water-fowl have been the agents of spreading some of its minute eggs, which may have been entangled in their feathers. The freshwater snail, Lymneus palustris, so abundant in English ponds, ranges uninterruptedly from Europe to Cashmere, and thence to the eastern parts of Asia. Helix aspersa, one of the commonest of our larger land-shells, is found in St. Helena and other distant countries. Some conchologists have conjectured that it was accidentally imported into St. Helena in some ship; for it is an eatable species, and these animals are capable of retaining life during long voyages, without air or nourishment.918

Helix putris (Succinea putris, Lam.), which is very common in Europe, reaching from Norway to Italy, is also reported to be found in the United States and Newfoundland. Since this animal typically lives along the edges of pools and streams where it’s quite moist, it’s possible that various waterfowl have helped spread some of its tiny eggs, which may have gotten caught in their feathers. The freshwater snail, Lymneus palustris, which is plentiful in English ponds, can be found continuously from Europe to Cashmere, and then to the eastern regions of Asia. Helix aspersa, one of our most common larger land snails, is found in St. Helena and other far-off places. Some conchologists have speculated that it may have accidentally been brought to St. Helena on a ship; it’s an edible species, and these snails can survive long journeys without air or food. 918

651 Perhaps no species has a better claim to be called cosmopolite than one of our British bivalves, Saxicava rugosa. It is spread over all the north-polar seas, and ranges in one direction through Europe to Senegal, occurring on both sides of the Atlantic; while in another it finds its way into the North Pacific, and thence to the Indian Ocean. Nor do its migrations cease till it reaches the Australian seas.

651 It's hard to find a species more deserving of the title "cosmopolitan" than one of our British clams, Saxicava rugosa. This species is found throughout the Arctic Ocean and extends in one direction from Europe to Senegal, existing on both sides of the Atlantic. In another direction, it travels into the North Pacific and then reaches the Indian Ocean. Its journey doesn't stop until it gets to the waters around Australia.

A British brachiopod, named Terebratula caput-serpentis, is common, according to Professor E. Forbes, to both sides of the North Atlantic, and to the South African and Chinese seas.

A British brachiopod called Terebratula caput-serpentis is commonly found on both sides of the North Atlantic, as well as in the South African and Chinese seas, according to Professor E. Forbes.

Confined range of other species.—Mr. Lowe, in a memoir published in the Cambridge Transactions in 1834, enumerates seventy-one species of land Mollusca, collected by him in the islands of Madeira and Porto Santo, sixty of which belonged to the genus Helix alone, including as sub-genera Bulimus and Achatina, and excluding Vitrina and Clausilia; forty-four of these are new. It is remarkable that very few of the above-mentioned species are common to the neighbouring archipelago of the Canaries; but it is a still more striking fact, that of the sixty species of the three genera above mentioned, thirty-one are natives of Porto Santo; whereas, in Madeira, which contains ten times the superficies, were found but twenty-nine. Of these only four were common to the two islands, which are separated by a distance of only twelve leagues; and two even of these four (namely Helix rhodostoma and H. ventrosa) are species of general diffusion, common to Madeira, the Canaries, and the south of Europe.919

Limited range of other species.—Mr. Lowe, in a paper published in the Cambridge Transactions in 1834, lists seventy-one species of land snails he collected in the islands of Madeira and Porto Santo. Sixty of these belong to the genus Helix alone, including the sub-genera Bulimus and Achatina, and excluding Vitrina and Clausilia; forty-four of these are new. It’s noteworthy that very few of the mentioned species are found in the nearby Canary Islands; however, it's even more surprising that out of the sixty species from the three genera mentioned, thirty-one are native to Porto Santo, while Madeira, which is ten times larger, has only twenty-nine. Of these, only four are found on both islands, which are just twelve leagues apart; and two of those four (specifically Helix rhodostoma and H. ventrosa) are widely distributed, being common to Madeira, the Canaries, and southern Europe.919

The confined range of these mollusks may easily be explained, if we admit that species have only one birth-place; and the only problem to be solved would relate to the exceptions—to account for the dissemination of some species throughout several islands, and the European continent. May not the eggs, when washed into the sea by the undermining of cliffs, or blown by a storm from the land, float uninjured to a distant shore?

The limited distribution of these mollusks can be easily explained if we accept that each species has just one place of origin. The only issue left to address would be the exceptions—specifically how some species are found across various islands and on the European continent. Could it be that their eggs, when washed into the ocean due to eroding cliffs or carried by storm winds from the land, float unharmed to far-off shores?

Their mode of diffusion.—Notwithstanding the proverbially slow motion of snails and mollusks in general, and although many aquatic species adhere constantly to the same rock for their whole lives, they are by no means destitute of provision for disseminating themselves rapidly over a wide area. "Some Mollusca," says Professor E. Forbes, "migrate in their larva state, for all of them undergo a metamorphosis either in the egg or out of the egg. The gasteropoda commence life under the form of a small spiral shell, and an animal furnished with ciliated wings, or lobes, like a pteropod, by means of which it can swim freely, and in this form can migrate with ease through the sea."920

Their way of spreading.—Even though snails and mollusks are known for their slow movement, and many aquatic species spend their entire lives clinging to the same rock, they are still well-equipped to spread themselves quickly over large areas. "Some Mollusca," says Professor E. Forbes, "migrate in their larval state, as all of them undergo a transformation either in the egg or after hatching. The gastropods start life as a small spiral shell and as a creature with ciliated wings or lobes, similar to a pteropod, which allows it to swim freely and easily migrate through the sea."920

652 We are accustomed to associate in our minds the idea of the greatest locomotive powers with the most mature and perfect state of each species of invertebrate animal, especially when they undergo a series of transformations; but in all the Mollusca the reverse is true. The young fry of the cockle, for example (Cardium), possess, when young or in the larva state, an apparatus which enables them both to swim and to be carried along easily by a marine current. (See fig. 99.)

652 We tend to associate the idea of the strongest locomotion with the most developed and refined stage of each type of invertebrate animal, especially when they go through changes; but in all Mollusca, it's the opposite. The young of the cockle, for instance (Cardium), have a system that allows them to swim and be easily swept along by ocean currents when they are young or in their larval stage. (See fig. 99.)

Fig. 99.Tne young fry of a cockle (Cardium pygmaeum,) from Loven's Kongl. Vetenskaps. Akadem. Handling, 1848.

Tne young fry of a cockle (Cardium pygmæum,) from Loven's Kongl. Vetenskaps. Akadem. Handling, 1848.

The young offspring of a cockle (Cardium pygmæum), from Loven's Kongl. Vetenskaps. Akadem. Handling, 1848.

A, The young just hatched, magnified 100 diameters.      B, the same farther advanced.

A, The young just hatched, magnified 100 times.      B, the same, further developed.

a, The ciliated organ of locomotion with its filamentous appendage b.
c, The rudimentary intestine.
d, The rudimentary shell.

a, The hair-like structure used for movement with its thread-like extension b.
c, The basic digestive tract.
d, The simple shell.

These small bodies here represented, which bear a considerable resemblance to the fry of the univalve, or gasteropodous shells above mentioned, are so minute at first as to be just visible to the naked eye. They begin to move about from the moment they are hatched, by means of the long cilia, a, a, placed on the edges of the locomotive disk or velum. This disk shrinks up as they increase in size, and gradually disappears, no trace of it being visible in the perfect animal.

These small bodies shown here, which look quite a bit like the larvae of the univalve or gastropod shells mentioned earlier, are so tiny at first that they're barely visible to the naked eye. They start moving around as soon as they hatch, using the long cilia, a, a, located on the edges of the moving disk or velum. This disk shrinks as they grow and eventually disappears, leaving no trace in the fully developed animal.

Some species of shell-bearing Mollusca lay their eggs in a sponge-like nidus, wherein the young remain enveloped for a time after their birth; and this buoyant substance floats far and wide as readily as sea-weed. The young of other viviparous tribes are often borne along entangled in sea-weed. Sometimes they are so light, that, like grains of sand, they can be easily moved by currents. Balani and Serpulæ are sometimes found adhering to floating cocoa-nuts, and even to fragments of pumice. In rivers and lakes, on the other hand, aquatic univalves usually attach their eggs to leaves and sticks which have fallen into the water, and which are liable to be swept away during floods, from tributaries to the main streams, and from thence to all parts of the same basins. Particular species may thus migrate during one season from the head waters of the Mississippi, or any other great river, to countries bordering the sea, at the distance of many thousand miles.

Some types of shell-bearing mollusks lay their eggs in a sponge-like nest, where the young stay wrapped up for a while after they’re born; this buoyant material floats around easily, just like seaweed. The young of other live-bearing species often get carried along tangled in seaweed. Sometimes they’re so lightweight that, like grains of sand, they can be easily moved by currents. Barnacles and tube worms are sometimes found clinging to floating coconuts and even pieces of pumice. In rivers and lakes, on the other hand, aquatic snails usually stick their eggs to leaves and sticks that have fallen into the water, which can be washed away during floods, moving from tributaries to the main streams, and then to all parts of the same basins. Certain species can thus migrate in one season from the upper reaches of the Mississippi or any other major river to coastal areas, covering distances of many thousands of miles.

An illustration of the mode of attachment of these eggs will be seen in the annexed cut. (Fig. 100.)

An illustration of how these eggs are attached can be seen in the attached image. (Fig. 100.)

The habit of some Testacea to adhere to floating wood is proved by their fixing themselves to the bottoms of ships. By this mode of conveyance Mytilus polymorphus, previously known only in the Danube and 653 Wolga, may have been brought to the Commercial Docks in the Thames, and to Hamburgh, where the species is now domiciled. But Mr. Gray suggests that as the animal is known to have the faculty of living for a very long time out of water, it is more probable that it was brought in Russian timber, than borne uninjured through the salt water at the bottom of a vessel.921

Some types of shellfish attach themselves to floating wood, which is shown by the way they attach to the bottoms of ships. This method of transportation might have brought Mytilus polymorphus, which was only found in the Danube and Wolga, to the Commercial Docks in the Thames and to Hamburg, where this species now lives. However, Mr. Gray suggests that since these animals can survive for a long time out of water, it’s more likely that they were brought in Russian timber rather than being carried unharmed through the saltwater underneath a ship.921

A lobster (Astacus marinus) was lately taken alive covered with living mussels (Mytilus edulis)922; and a large female crab (Cancer pagurus), covered with oysters, and bearing also Anomia ephippium, and Actiniæ, was taken in April, 1832, off the English coast. The oysters, seven in number, include individuals of six years' growth, and the two largest are four inches long and three inches and a half broad. Both the crab and the oysters were seen alive by Mr. Robert Brown.923

A lobster (Astacus marinus) was recently found alive, covered in living mussels (Mytilus edulis)922; and a large female crab (Cancer pagurus) that had oysters and was also carrying Anomia ephippium and sea anemones was caught in April 1832 off the English coast. The oysters, totaling seven, include individuals that are six years old, and the two largest measure four inches long and three and a half inches wide. Both the crab and the oysters were observed alive by Mr. Robert Brown.923

Fig. 100.Eggs of Freshwater mollusks.

Eggs of Freshwater mollusks.

Freshwater mollusk eggs.

Fig. 1. Eggs of Ampullaria ovata (a fluviatile species) fixed to a small sprig which had fallen into the water.

Fig. 1. Eggs of Ampullaria ovata (a freshwater species) attached to a small branch that had fallen into the water.

Fig. 2. Eggs of Planorbis albus, attached to a dead leaf lying under water.

Fig. 2. Eggs of Planorbis albus, attached to a dead leaf sitting underwater.

Fig. 3. Eggs of the common Limneus (L. vulgaris), adhering to a dead stick under water.

Fig. 3. Eggs of the common Limneus (L. vulgaris), sticking to a dead stick underwater.

From this example we learn the manner in which oysters may be diffused over every part of the sea where the crab wanders; and if they are at length carried to a spot where there is nothing but fine mud, the foundation of a new oyster-bank may be laid on the death of the crab. In this instance the oysters survived the crab many days, and were killed at last only by long exposure to the air.

From this example, we see how oysters can spread throughout the sea where crabs move. If they eventually end up in an area covered only with fine mud, a new oyster bed can be created after the crab dies. In this case, the oysters outlived the crab for several days, and they were finally killed only by prolonged exposure to the air.

Geographical Distribution and Migrations of Zoophytes.

Zoophytes are very imperfectly known; but there can be little doubt that each maritime region possesses species peculiar to itself. The Madrepores, or lamelliferous Polyparia, are found in their fullest development only in the tropical seas of Polynesia and the East and West Indies; and this family is represented only by a few species in our seas. The zoophytes of the Mediterranean, according to Ehrenberg, differ almost entirely from those of the Red Sea, although only seventy miles distant. Out of 120 species of Anthozoa, only two are common to both seas.924 Péron and Lesueur, after studying the Holothuriæ, Medusæ, and other congeners of delicate and changeable forms, came to the conclusion that each kind has its place of residence determined by the temperature necessary to support its existence. Thus, for example, they found the abode of Pyrosoma Atlantica to be confined to one particular region of the Atlantic Ocean.925

Zoophytes are not very well understood, but it's clear that each ocean area has its own unique species. The Madrepores, or layered Polyparia, are most abundant in the tropical waters of Polynesia and the East and West Indies; this group is only represented by a few species in our seas. According to Ehrenberg, the zoophytes in the Mediterranean are almost completely different from those in the Red Sea, even though they are only seventy miles apart. Out of 120 species of Anthozoa, only two are found in both seas.924 Péron and Lesueur, after studying the Holothuriæ, Medusæ, and other similar forms that are delicate and variable, concluded that each type has its own specific habitat determined by the temperature needed for its survival. For instance, they found that Pyrosoma Atlantica is restricted to one specific area of the Atlantic Ocean.925

Let us now inquire how the transportation of zoophytes from one part of the globe to another is effected. Many of them, as in the families Flustra and Sertularia, attach themselves to sea-weed, and are occasionally drifted along with it. Many fix themselves to the shells of Mollusca, and are thus borne along by them to short distances. Others, like some species of sea-pens, float about in the ocean, and are usually believed to possess powers of spontaneous motion. But the most frequent mode of transportation consists in the buoyancy of their eggs, or certain small vesicles, which are detached, and are capable of becoming the foundation of a new colony. These gems, as they are called, have, in many instances, a locomotive power of their own, by which they proceed in a determinate direction for several days after separation from the parent. They are propelled by means of numerous short threads or ciliæ, which are in constant and rapid vibration; and, when thus supported in the water, they may be borne along by currents to a great distance.

Let’s now explore how the transportation of zoophytes from one part of the world to another happens. Many of them, like those in the families Flustra and Sertularia, attach themselves to seaweed and occasionally get carried along with it. Some attach themselves to the shells of mollusks and are transported short distances by them. Others, like certain species of sea pens, float around in the ocean and are generally thought to have the ability for spontaneous movement. However, the most common way they are transported is through the buoyancy of their eggs or tiny vesicles that break off and can start a new colony. These tiny organisms, often called "gems," can, in many cases, move on their own for several days after separating from the parent. They are moved by numerous short threads or ciliæ, which are constantly and rapidly vibrating; and, when they are floating in the water, they can get carried along by currents over great distances.

That some zoophytes adhere to floating bodies, is proved by their being found attached to the bottoms of ships, like certain Testacea before alluded to.

That some zoophytes stick to floating objects is shown by them being found attached to the undersides of ships, just like certain Testacea mentioned earlier.

Geographical Distribution and Migrations of Insects.

Before I conclude this sketch of the manner in which the habitable parts of the earth are shared out among particular assemblages of organic beings, I must offer a few remarks on insects, which, by their numbers and the variety of their powers and instincts, exert a prodigious influence in the economy of animate nature. As a large portion of these minute creatures are strictly dependent for their subsistence on certain species of vegetables, the entomological provinces must coincide in considerable degree with the botanical.

Before I wrap up this overview of how the livable areas of the earth are distributed among different groups of living beings, I want to say a few words about insects. Their sheer numbers and the range of their abilities and instincts have a huge impact on the balance of life. Since many of these tiny creatures rely heavily on specific types of plants for survival, the areas studied in entomology largely overlap with those in botany.

655 All the insects, says Latreille, brought from the eastern parts of Asia and China, whatever be their latitude and temperature, are distinct from those of Europe and of Africa. The insects of the United States, although often approaching very close to our own, are, with very few exceptions, specifically distinguishable by some characters. In South America, the equinoctial lands of New Granada and Peru on the one side, and of Guiana on the other, contain for the most part distinct groups; the Andes forming the division, and interposing a narrow line of severe cold between climates otherwise very similar.926

655 According to Latreille, all the insects brought from the eastern regions of Asia and China, regardless of their latitude and climate, are different from those found in Europe and Africa. The insects in the United States, while often very similar to ours, are generally distinctly identifiable by certain features. In South America, the equatorial areas of New Granada and Peru on one side, and Guiana on the other, mostly contain unique groups; the Andes act as a barrier, creating a narrow zone of severe cold that separates otherwise similar climates.926

Migratory instincts.—Nearly all the insects of the United States and Canada, differ specifically from the European; while those of Greenland appear to be in a great measure identical with our own. Some insects are very local; while a few, on the contrary, are common to remote countries, between which the torrid zone and the ocean intervene. Thus our painted lady butterfly (Vanessa cardui) re-appears at the Cape of Good Hope and in New Holland and Japan with scarcely a varying streak.927 The same species is said to be one of the few insects which are universally dispersed over the earth, being found in Europe, Asia, Africa, and America; and its wide range is the more interesting, because it seems explained by its migratory instinct, seconded, no doubt, by a capacity, enjoyed by few species, of enduring a great diversity of temperature.

Migratory instincts.—Almost all the insects in the United States and Canada are different from those in Europe, while the insects in Greenland seem to be mostly identical to ours. Some insects are very localized, while a few, on the other hand, can be found in far-off countries, separated by tropical climates and oceans. For example, our painted lady butterfly (Vanessa cardui) shows up again in places like the Cape of Good Hope, New Holland, and Japan with barely any changes. 927 This species is said to be one of the few insects that can be found all over the world, appearing in Europe, Asia, Africa, and America; its broad distribution is especially interesting because it's likely due to its migratory instinct, supported, undoubtedly, by a rare ability among species to tolerate a wide range of temperatures.

A vast swarm of this species, forming a column from ten to fifteen feet broad, was, a few years since, observed in the Canton de Vaud; they traversed the country with great rapidity from north to south, all flying onwards in regular order, close together, and not turning from their course on the approach of other objects. Professor Bonelli, of Turin, observed, in March of the same year, a similar swarm of the same species, also directing their flight from north to south, in Piedmont, in such immense numbers that at night the flowers were literally covered with them. They had been traced from Coni, Raconi, Susa, &c. A similar flight at the end of the last century is recorded by M. Louch in the Memoirs of the Academy of Turin. The fact is the more worthy of notice, because the caterpillars of this butterfly are not gregarious, but solitary from the moment that they are hatched; and this instinct remains dormant, while generation after generation passes away, till it suddenly displays itself in full energy when their numbers happen to be in excess.

A huge swarm of this species, stretching ten to fifteen feet wide, was spotted a few years ago in the Canton de Vaud. They moved quickly across the country from north to south, flying in a tight formation without breaking their path, even when other objects came close. Professor Bonelli from Turin saw a similar swarm of the same species in March of the same year, also flying from north to south in Piedmont, in such enormous numbers that at night, the flowers were completely covered with them. They were tracked from Coni, Raconi, Susa, etc. M. Louch documented a similar occurrence at the end of the last century in the Memoirs of the Academy of Turin. This is particularly noteworthy because the caterpillars of this butterfly are not social; they are solitary from the moment they hatch, and this instinct stays inactive while generation after generation passes until it suddenly emerges with great intensity when their numbers become too large.

Not only peculiar species, but certain types, distinguish particular countries; and there are groups, observes Kirby, which represent each other in distant regions, whether in their form, their functions, or in both. Thus the honey and wax of Europe, Asia, and Africa, are in each case prepared by bees congenerous with our common hive-bee (Apis, Latr.); while, in America, this genus is nowhere indigenous, but is replaced by Melipona, Trigona, and Euglossa; and in New Holland by 656 a still different but undescribed type.928 The European bee (Apis mellifica), although not a native of the new world, is now established both in North and South America. It was introduced into the United States by some of the early settlers, and has since overspread the vast forests of the interior, building hives in the decayed trunks of trees. "The Indians," says Irving, "consider them as the harbinger of the white man, as the buffalo is of the red man, and say that in proportion as the bee advances the Indian and the buffalo retire. It is said," continues the same writer, "that the wild bee is seldom to be met with at any great distance from the frontier, and that they have always been the heralds of civilization, preceding it as it advanced from the Atlantic borders. Some of the ancient settlers of the west even pretend to give the very year when the honey-bee first crossed the Mississippi."929 The same species is now also naturalized in Van Diemen's Land and New Zealand.

Not only unique species, but certain types, also define specific countries; and there are groups, as noted by Kirby, that share similarities in distant regions, whether in their appearance, their roles, or both. For example, honey and wax from Europe, Asia, and Africa are all made by bees related to our common hive bee (Apis, Latr.); while in America, this genus is not native and is instead replaced by Melipona, Trigona, and Euglossa; and in Australia, by another yet-to-be-described species.928 The European bee (Apis mellifica), although not originally from the New World, is now found in both North and South America. It was brought to the United States by early settlers and has since spread throughout the vast forests of the interior, nesting in decayed tree trunks. "The Indians," writes Irving, "view them as a sign of the white man’s arrival, just as the buffalo is of the red man, saying that as the bee moves forward, the Indian and the buffalo retreat. It is said," continues the same writer, "that the wild bee is rarely found far from the frontier, and they have always indicated the presence of civilization, preceding it as it moved away from the Atlantic coast. Some of the early settlers in the west even claim to know the exact year when the honey bee first crossed the Mississippi."929 This species is now also established in Tasmania and New Zealand.

As almost all insects are winged, they can readily spread themselves wherever their progress is not opposed by uncongenial climates, or by seas, mountains, and other physical impediments; and these barriers they can sometimes surmount by abandoning themselves to violent winds, which, as I before stated, when speaking of the dispersion of seeds (p. 618.), may in a few hours carry them to very considerable distances. On the Andes some sphinxes and flies have been observed by Humboldt, at the height of 19,180 feet above the sea, and which appeared to him to have been involuntarily carried into these regions by ascending currents of air.930

As almost all insects have wings, they can easily spread to different areas wherever their movement isn't hindered by harsh climates, seas, mountains, or other physical obstacles. Sometimes, they can overcome these barriers by taking advantage of strong winds, which, as I mentioned earlier when discussing the spread of seeds (p. 618.), can carry them significant distances in just a few hours. Humboldt observed some sphinx moths and flies on the Andes at an altitude of 19,180 feet above sea level, which appeared to have been unintentionally pushed into these high regions by rising air currents.930

White mentions a remarkable shower of aphides which seem to have emigrated, with an east wind, from the great hop plantations of Kent and Sussex, and blackened the shrubs and vegetables where they alighted at Selbourne, spreading at the same time in great clouds all along the vale from Farnham to Alton. These aphides are sometimes accompanied by vast numbers of the common lady-bird (Coccinella septempunctata), which feed upon them.931

White talks about a surprising influx of aphids that appear to have traveled with an east wind from the large hop farms in Kent and Sussex. They darkened the shrubs and vegetables when they landed in Selbourne, while also spreading in huge swarms throughout the valley from Farnham to Alton. These aphids are often joined by large numbers of the common ladybug (Coccinella septempunctata), which feed on them.931

It is remarkable, says Kirby, that many of the insects which are occasionally observed to emigrate, as, for instance, the Libellulæ, Coccinellæ, Carabi, Cicadæ, &c. are not usually social insects; but seem to congregate, like swallows, merely for the purpose of emigration.932 Here, therefore, we have an example of an instinct developing itself on certain rare emergencies, causing unsocial species to become gregarious and to venture sometimes even to cross the ocean.

It's interesting, Kirby points out, that many of the insects we occasionally see migrating, like dragonflies, ladybugs, ground beetles, cicadas, etc., aren’t typically social insects. They seem to gather together, much like swallows, just for the purpose of migrating.932 So, in this case, we have an example of an instinct that emerges in rare situations, making unsocial species come together and sometimes even brave crossing the ocean.

The armies of locusts which darken the air in Africa, and traverse the globe from Turkey to our southern counties in England, are well known to all. When the western gales sweep over the Pampas they 657 bear along with them myriads of insects of various kinds. As a proof of the manner in which species may be thus diffused, I may mention that when the Creole frigate was lying in the outer roads off Buenos Ayres, in 1819, at the distance of six miles from the land, her decks and rigging were suddenly covered by thousands of flies and grains of sand. The sides of the vessel had just received a fresh coat of paint, to which the insects adhered in such numbers as to spot and disfigure the vessel, and to render it necessary partially to renew the paint.933 Captain W. H. Smyth was obliged to repaint his vessel, the Adventure, in the Mediterranean, from the same cause. He was on his way from Malta to Tripoli, when a southern wind blowing from the coast of Africa, then one hundred miles distant, drove such myriads of flies upon the fresh paint, that not the smallest point was left unoccupied by insects.

The swarms of locusts that darken the skies in Africa and travel across the globe from Turkey to southern England are familiar to everyone. When the western winds blow over the Pampas, they carry countless insects of different kinds. To illustrate how species can spread in this way, I can mention that when the Creole frigate was anchored six miles off the coast of Buenos Aires in 1819, its decks and rigging were suddenly covered with thousands of flies and grains of sand. The vessel had just been freshly painted, but the insects stuck to it in such large numbers that they spotted and ruined the paint job, making it necessary to repaint part of the ship. Captain W. H. Smyth also had to repaint his ship, the Adventure, in the Mediterranean for the same reason. While traveling from Malta to Tripoli, a southern wind blowing from Africa, which was then a hundred miles away, blew in such swarms of flies onto the fresh paint that not a single spot was left untouched by insects.

To the southward of the river Plate, off Cape St. Antonio, and at the distance of fifty miles from land, several large dragon-flies alighted on the Adventure frigate, during Captain King's late expedition to the Straits of Magellan. If the wind abates when insects are thus crossing the sea, the most delicate species are not necessarily drowned; for many can repose without sinking on the water. The slender long-legged tipulæ have been seen standing on the surface of the sea, when driven out far from our coast, and took wing immediately on being approached.934 Exotic beetles are sometimes thrown on our shore, which revive after having been long drenched in salt water; and the periodical appearance of some conspicuous butterflies amongst us, after being unseen some for five others for fifty years, has been ascribed, not without probability, to the agency of the winds.

To the south of the River Plate, off Cape St. Antonio, and fifty miles from land, several large dragonflies landed on the Adventure frigate during Captain King's recent expedition to the Straits of Magellan. If the wind dies down while insects are crossing the sea, the most delicate species don’t necessarily drown; many can rest on the water without sinking. Slender, long-legged tipulæ have been seen standing on the ocean's surface when pushed far from our coast, taking flight immediately when approached.934 Exotic beetles are sometimes washed up on our shore, coming back to life after being soaked in saltwater for a long time; and the periodic appearance of certain striking butterflies among us, after being absent for five or even fifty years, is likely due to the influence of the winds.

Inundations of rivers, observes Kirby, if they happen at any season except in the depths of winter, always carry down a number of insects, floating on the surface of bits of stick, weeds, &c.; so that when the waters subside, the entomologist may generally reap a plentiful harvest. In the dissemination, moreover, of these minute beings, as in that of plants, the larger animals play their part. Insects are, in numberless instances, borne along in the coats of animals, or the feathers of birds; and the eggs of some species are capable, like seeds, of resisting the digestive powers of the stomach, and after they are swallowed with herbage, may be ejected again unharmed in the dung.

Floods, Kirby notes, if they occur at any time other than the depths of winter, usually carry away a variety of insects, floating on pieces of wood, weeds, etc.; so that when the water recedes, the entomologist can typically gather a rich assortment. Additionally, in the distribution of these tiny creatures, similar to that of plants, larger animals play a role. In many cases, insects are carried in the fur of animals or the feathers of birds; and the eggs of some species can, like seeds, survive the digestive processes of the stomach and may be expelled unharmed in the feces after being ingested with vegetation.

Geographical Distribution and Diffusion of Man.

I have reserved for the last some observations on the range and diffusion of the human species over the earth, and the influence of man in spreading other animals and plants, especially the terrestrial.

I have set aside some final thoughts on the distribution and spread of humans across the planet, as well as the impact of humans in introducing other animals and plants, particularly land species.

Many naturalists have amused themselves in speculating on the probable birth-place of mankind, the point from which, if we assume the whole human race to have descended from a single pair, the tide of emigration 658 must originally have proceeded. It has been always a favorite conjecture, that this birth-place was situated within or near the tropics, where perpetual summer reigns, and where fruits, herbs, and roots are plentifully supplied throughout the year. The climate of these regions, it has been said, is suited to a being born without any covering, and who had not yet acquired the arts of building habitations or providing clothes.

Many naturalists have entertained themselves by speculating on the likely birthplace of humanity, the place from which, if we believe that all humans descended from a single pair, the flow of migration 658 must have initially started. It has always been a popular theory that this birthplace was located within or near the tropics, where it’s perpetually warm, and where fruits, vegetables, and roots are abundantly available year-round. The climate in these areas, it has been suggested, is ideal for a being born without any clothing, and who had not yet learned how to build shelters or make clothes.

Progress of Human Population.—"The hunter state," it has been argued, "which Montesquieu placed the first, was probably only the second stage to which mankind arrived; since so many arts must have been invented to catch a salmon, or a deer, that society could no longer have been in its infancy when they came into use."935 When regions where the spontaneous fruits of the earth abound became overpeopled, men would naturally diffuse themselves over the neighboring parts of the temperate zone; but a considerable time would probably elapse before this event took place; and it is possible, as a writer before cited observes, that in the interval before the multiplication of their numbers and their increasing wants had compelled them to emigrate, some arts to take animals were invented, but far inferior to what we see practised at this day among savages. As their habitations gradually advanced into the temperate zone, the new difficulties they had to encounter would call forth by degrees the spirit of invention, and the probability of such inventions always rises with the number of people involved in the same necessity.936

Progress of Human Population.—It has been suggested that "the hunter state," which Montesquieu placed as the first stage, was likely only the second stage that humanity reached. This is because so many skills must have been developed to catch a salmon or a deer, indicating that society was no longer in its infancy when these techniques began to be used.935 When areas where wild fruits were plentiful became overcrowded, people would naturally spread into neighboring regions of the temperate zone. However, it would probably take a significant amount of time before this happened. It’s possible, as a previously mentioned writer notes, that during the time before their population growth and increasing needs forced them to migrate, some methods of hunting animals were developed, but those methods were likely much simpler than what we see today among indigenous peoples. As their settlements gradually moved into the temperate zone, the new challenges they faced would gradually inspire creativity, and the chances of such innovations typically increase with the number of people facing the same challenges.936

A distinguished modern writer, who coincides for the most part in the views above mentioned, has introduced one of the persons in his second dialogue, as objecting to the theory of the human race having gradually advanced from a savage to a civilized state, on the ground that "the first man must have inevitably been destroyed by the elements or devoured by savage beasts, so infinitely his superiors in physical force."937 He then contends against the difficulty here started by various arguments, all of which were, perhaps, superfluous; for if a philosopher is pleased to indulge in conjectures on this subject, why should he not assign, as the original seat of man, some one of those large islands within the tropics, which are as free from large beasts of prey as Van Diemen's Land or Australia? Here man may have remained for a period, peculiar to a single island, just as some of the large anthropomorphous species are now limited to one island within the tropics. In such a situation, the new-born race might have lived in security, though far more helpless than the New Holland savages, and might have found abundance of vegetable food. Colonies may afterwards have been sent forth from this mother country, and then the peopling of the earth may have proceeded according to the hypothesis before alluded to.

A prominent modern writer, who largely shares the views mentioned earlier, includes one of the characters in his second dialogue arguing against the theory that the human race gradually progressed from a savage to a civilized state. They claim that "the first man would have inevitably been killed by the elements or eaten by wild animals, which were far superior to him in physical strength."937 He then counters this difficulty with various arguments, most of which might be unnecessary; after all, if a philosopher wants to speculate on this topic, why shouldn’t he propose that the original home of humanity was one of those large islands in the tropics, which are as free from large predators as Van Diemen's Land or Australia? In such an environment, humans could have thrived for a time specific to that island, similar to how some large ape species are now confined to a single tropical island. In this setting, the emerging human race might have lived safely, even though they would have been much more vulnerable than the New Holland savages, while also finding plenty of plant-based food. Colonies could later have been established from this parent country, leading to the spread of people across the earth according to the previously mentioned hypothesis.

To form a probable conjecture respecting the country from whence the early civilization of India was derived, has been found almost as difficult as to determine the original birth-place of the human race. That the dawn of oriental civilization did not arise within the limits of the tropics, 659 is the conclusion to which Baron William von Humboldt has come after much patient research into "the diversities of the structure of language and their influence on the mental development of the human race." According to him the ancient Zend country from whence the spread of knowledge and the arts has been traced in a south-easterly direction, lay to the north-west of the upper Indus.938

Determining where the early civilization of India came from is nearly as challenging as pinpointing the original birthplace of humanity. Baron William von Humboldt concluded, after extensive research into "the differences in language structure and their impact on human mental development," that the origins of oriental civilization did not lie within the tropics. He suggested that the ancient Zend region, from which knowledge and the arts spread southeast, was located to the northwest of the upper Indus. 659938

As to the time of the first appearance of man upon the earth, if we are to judge from the discordance of opinion amongst celebrated chronologers, not even a rude approximation has yet been made towards determining a point of so much interest. The problem seems hitherto to have baffled the curiosity of the antiquary, if possible, more completely than the fixing on a geographical site for the original habitation of the ancestors of the human race. The Chevalier Bunsen, in his elaborate and philosophical work on Ancient Egypt,939 has satisfied not a few of the learned, by an appeal to monumental inscriptions still extant, that the successive dynasties of kings may be traced back without a break, to Menes, and that the date of his reign would correspond with the year 3640 B. C. He supposes at the same time, what is most reasonable, that the Egyptian people must have existed for a long period (probably at least for five centuries), in their earlier and less settled state, before they reached the point of civilization at which Menes consolidated them into a great and united empire. This would carry us back to upwards of 4000 years B. C., or to an epoch coincident with that commonly set down for the creation of the world in accordance with computations founded on the combined ages of the successive antediluvian patriarchs. It follows that the same epoch of Menes is anterior by a great many centuries to the most ancient of the dates usually fixed upon for the Mosaic deluge. The fact that no record or tradition of any great and overwhelming flood has been detected in the mythology, or monumental annals of the Egyptians, will suggest many reflections to a geologist who has weighed well the evidence we possess of a variety of partial deluges which have happened in districts not free like Egypt, for the last 3000 years, from earthquakes and other causes of great aqueous catastrophes. The tales and legends of calamitous floods preserved in Greece, Asia Minor, the southern shores of the Baltic, China, Peru, and Chili, have, as we have seen, been all of them handed down to us by the inhabitants of regions in which the operation of natural causes in modern times, and the recurrence of a succession of disastrous floods, afford us data for interpreting the meaning of the obscure traditions of an illiterate age.940

As for when humans first appeared on earth, judging by the disagreements among well-known chronologists, we still haven’t gotten even a rough estimate for such an intriguing topic. This question seems to have puzzled researchers even more than pinpointing the geographical location of the original home of human ancestors. Chevalier Bunsen, in his detailed and thoughtful work on Ancient Egypt,939 has convinced many scholars, by referring to surviving monumental inscriptions, that the different dynasties of kings can be traced back in an unbroken line to Menes, and that the date of his reign likely corresponds to the year 3640 B.C. He also reasonably assumes that the Egyptian people must have existed for a long time (probably at least five centuries) in a less settled state before reaching the level of civilization where Menes unified them into a large empire. This would take us back to over 4000 years B. C., which aligns with the timeframe typically suggested for the creation of the world based on the combined ages of the ancient patriarchs before the flood. Consequently, Menes’s period precedes by many centuries the earliest dates usually assigned to the Mosaic flood. The absence of any records or traditions about a massive flood in the mythology or monumental history of the Egyptians might lead a geologist to reflect on the evidence we have of various partial floods that have occurred in other areas, unlike Egypt, over the last 3000 years caused by earthquakes and other major water-related disasters. The stories and legends of catastrophic floods preserved in Greece, Asia Minor, the southern Baltic shores, China, Peru, and Chile, as we’ve seen, have all been passed down by people in regions where the impacts of natural causes today and the recurrence of many destructive floods give us insights into the meaning of the unclear traditions from an uneducated time.940

In his learned treatise on ancient chronology, Dr. Hales has selected, from a much greater number, a list of no less than 120 authors, all of whom give a different period for the epoch of the creation of the world, 660 the extreme range of difference between them amounting to no less than 3268 years. It appears that even amongst authorities, who in England are generally regarded, as orthodox, there is a variance, not of years or of one or two centuries, but of upwards of a millennium, according as they have preferred to follow the Hebrew, or the Samaritan, or the Greek versions of the Mosaic writings. Can we then wonder that they who decipher the monuments of Egypt, or the geologist who interprets the earth's autobiography, should arrive at views respecting the date of an ancient empire, or the age of our planet, irreconcilable with every one of these numerous and conflicting chronologies? The want of agreement amongst the learned in regard to the probable date of the deluge of Noah is a source of far greater perplexity and confusion than our extreme uncertainty as to the epoch of the creation,—the deluge being a comparatively modern event, from which the repeopling of the earth and the history of the present races of mankind is made to begin.

In his detailed study on ancient timelines, Dr. Hales has chosen, from a much larger selection, a list of 120 authors, each of whom proposes a different date for the creation of the world, 660 with the total difference between them reaching as much as 3268 years. It seems that even among those who are generally seen as credible in England, there is a discrepancy of not just years or a couple of centuries, but over a thousand years, depending on whether they follow the Hebrew, Samaritan, or Greek versions of the Mosaic texts. Can we be surprised that those who interpret the monuments of Egypt, or the geologists who study the history of our planet, come to conclusions about the timeframe of an ancient civilization, or the age of the Earth, that conflict with each of these numerous and differing chronologies? The lack of consensus among scholars regarding the likely date of Noah's flood creates far greater confusion and frustration than our considerable uncertainty about the creation date—the flood being a relatively recent event from which the repopulation of Earth and the story of the current human races begins.

Naturalists have long felt that to render probable the received opinion that all the leading varieties of the human family have originally sprung from a single pair, (a doctrine against which there appears to me to be no sound objection,) a much greater lapse of time is required for the slow and gradual formation of races, (such as the Caucasian, Mongolian, and Negro,) than is embraced in any of the popular systems of chronology. The existence of two of those marked varieties above mentioned can be traced back 3000 years before the present time, or to the painting of pictures, preserved in the tombs or on the walls of buried temples in Egypt. In these we behold the Negro and Caucasian physiognomies portrayed as faithfully and in as strong contrast as if the likenesses of those races had been taken yesterday. When we consider therefore the extreme slowness of the changes, which climate and other modifying causes have produced in modern times, we must allow for a vast series of antecedent ages, in the course of which the long-continued influence of similar external circumstances gave rise to peculiarities, probably increased in many successive generations, until they were fixed by hereditary transmission. The characteristic forms and features thus acquired by certain tribes, may have been afterwards diffused by migration from a few centres over wide continental spaces. The theory, therefore, that all the races of man have come from one common stock receives support from every investigation which forces us to expand our ideas of the duration of past time, or which multiplies the number of years that have passed away since the origin of man. Hitherto, geology has neither enlarged nor circumscribed the "human period;" but simply proved that in the history of animated nature it is comparatively modern, or the last of a long series of antecedent epochs, in each of which the earth has been successively peopled by distinct species of animals and plants.

Naturalists have long believed that to make the widely accepted idea that all the main varieties of the human race originated from a single pair seem likely, (a belief that I find no strong objections against,) a much longer period is needed for the slow and gradual development of races, (like the Caucasian, Mongolian, and Black,) than what any popular timelines suggest. The existence of two of these distinct races mentioned can be traced back 3,000 years before today, to the paintings preserved in the tombs or on the walls of ancient temples in Egypt. In these, we see the Black and Caucasian features depicted as accurately and in as sharp contrast as if those portraits had been made just yesterday. When we consider the extreme slowness of the changes that climate and other factors have produced in recent times, we must account for a vast number of preceding ages, during which the long-lasting influence of similar external conditions led to unique traits, likely enhanced over many generations until they became established through hereditary passing. The specific forms and traits acquired by certain groups may have later spread through migration from a few centers across large continental areas. Therefore, the theory that all human races have descended from one common ancestor is supported by every investigation urging us to broaden our understanding of how long ago things happened, or which increases the number of years since humans first appeared. So far, geology has neither expanded nor limited the "human period;" it has merely shown that in the history of living beings, it is relatively modern, being the most recent of a long series of earlier periods, each of which has seen the earth populated by different species of animals and plants.

In an early stage of society the necessity of hunting acts as a principle of repulsion, causing men to spread with the greatest rapidity over a country, until the whole is covered with scattered settlements. It has been calculated that eight hundred acres of hunting-ground produce only 661 as much food as half an acre of arable land. When the game has been in a great measure exhausted, and a state of pasturage succeeds, the several hunter tribes, being already scattered, may multiply in a short time into the greatest number which the pastoral state is capable of sustaining. The necessity, says Brand, thus imposed upon the two savage states, of dispersing themselves far and wide over the country, affords a reason why, at a very early period, the worst parts of the earth may have become inhabited.

In the early stages of society, the need for hunting causes people to spread rapidly across a region until it's filled with scattered settlements. It's been estimated that eight hundred acres of hunting ground provide only 661 as much food as half an acre of farmland. Once the game has largely been depleted and grazing begins, the various hunting tribes, already dispersed, can quickly increase in number to the maximum that the pastoral lifestyle can support. According to Brand, this necessity for both wild states to spread widely across the land explains why even the least hospitable parts of the earth might have been settled very early on.

But this reason, it may be said, is only applicable in as far as regards the peopling of a continuous continent; whereas the smallest islands, however remote from continents, have almost always been found inhabited by man. St. Helena, it is true, afforded an exception; for when that island was discovered in 1501, it was only inhabited by sea-fowl, and occasionally by seals and turtles, and was covered with a forest of trees and shrubs, all of species peculiar to it, with one or two exceptions, and which seem to have been expressly created for this remote and insulated spot.941

But this reason only applies to the settlement of a continuous continent; however, even the smallest islands, no matter how far from continents, have almost always been found to be inhabited by humans. St. Helena is a notable exception; when that island was discovered in 1501, it was only home to sea birds and occasionally seals and turtles. It was covered in a forest of trees and shrubs, most of which were unique to the island, with a couple of exceptions, and they seemed to be specifically created for this isolated and remote location.941

The islands also of Mauritius, Bourbon, Pitcairns, and Juan Fernandez, and those of the Galapagos archipelago, one of which is seventy miles long, were inhabited when first discovered, and, what is more remarkable than all, the Falkland Islands, which together are 120 miles in length by 60 in breadth, and abounding in food fit for the support of man.

The islands of Mauritius, Bourbon, Pitcairn, and Juan Fernandez, as well as those in the Galapagos archipelago, one of which is seventy miles long, were already inhabited when they were first discovered. Even more notably, the Falkland Islands, which measure 120 miles long and 60 miles wide, are rich in food suitable for sustaining human life.

Drifting of canoes to vast distances.—But very few of the numerous coral islets and volcanoes of the vast Pacific, capable of sustaining a few families of men, have been found untenanted; and we have, therefore, to inquire whence and by what means, if all the members of the great human family have had one common source, could those savages have migrated. Cook, Forster, and others, have remarked that parties of savages in their canoes must have often lost their way, and must have been driven on distant shores, where they were forced to remain, deprived both of the means and of the requisite intelligence for returning to their own country. Thus Captain Cook found on the island of Wateoo three inhabitants of Otaheite, who had been drifted thither in a canoe, although the distance between the two isles is 550 miles. In 1696, two canoes, containing thirty persons, who had left Ancorso, were thrown by contrary winds and storms on the island of Samar, one of the Philippines, at a distance of 800 miles. In 1721, two canoes, one of which contained twenty-four, and the other six persons, men, women, and children, were drifted from an island called Farroilep to the island of Guaham, one of the Marians, a distance of 200 miles.942

Drifting of canoes to vast distances.—Very few of the many coral islets and volcanoes in the vast Pacific, capable of supporting a few families, have been found uninhabited. Therefore, we need to explore from where and by what means, if all members of the human family have a common origin, those people could have migrated. Cook, Forster, and others have pointed out that groups of people in their canoes must have often lost their way, ending up on distant shores where they were forced to stay, lacking both the means and knowledge to return to their homeland. For example, Captain Cook discovered on the island of Wateoo three inhabitants from Otaheite who had drifted there in a canoe, despite the fact that the two islands are 550 miles apart. In 1696, two canoes carrying thirty people who had left Ancorso were blown by strong winds and storms onto Samar, one of the Philippines, a distance of 800 miles. In 1721, two canoes, one with twenty-four people and the other with six, including men, women, and children, were carried from an island called Farroilep to the island of Guaham, one of the Marianas, a distance of 200 miles.942

Kotzebue, when investigating the Coral Isles of Radack, at the eastern extremity of the Caroline Isles, became acquainted with a person of the name of Kadu, who was a native of Ulea, an isle 1500 miles distant, from which he had been drifted with a party. Kadu and three of his 662 countrymen one day left Ulea in a sailing boat, when a violent storm arose, and drove them out of their course: they drifted about the open sea for eight months, according to their reckoning by the moon, making a knot on a cord at every new moon. Being expert fishermen, they subsisted entirely on the produce of the sea; and when the rain fell, laid in as much fresh water as they had vessels to contain it. "Kadu," says Kotzebue, "who was the best diver, frequently went down to the bottom of the sea, where it is well known that the water is not so salt, with a cocoa-nut shell, with only a small opening."943 When these unfortunate men reached the isles of Radack, every hope and almost every feeling had died within them; their sail had long been destroyed, their canoe had long been the sport of winds and waves, and they were picked up by the inhabitants of Aur in a state of insensibility; but by the hospitable care of those islanders they soon recovered, and were restored to perfect health.944

Kotzebue, while exploring the Coral Isles of Radack, at the eastern edge of the Caroline Isles, met a person named Kadu, who was a native of Ulea, an island 1500 miles away. He had been carried off with a group. One day, Kadu and three of his fellow countrymen set out from Ulea in a sailing boat when a powerful storm hit and threw them off course. They drifted in the open sea for eight months, according to their lunar calendar, tying a knot in a cord at each new moon. Being skilled fishermen, they lived entirely off the sea's bounty; and when it rained, they collected as much fresh water as their containers could hold. "Kadu," says Kotzebue, "who was the best diver, often descended to the ocean floor, where the water is known to be less salty, using a coconut shell with just a small opening." When these unfortunate men finally reached the isles of Radack, they had lost all hope and almost all feelings; their sail had long been torn apart, and their canoe had been at the mercy of the winds and waves. They were found by the people of Aur in a state of unconsciousness, but thanks to the kind care of those islanders, they soon recovered and regained their full health.

Captain Beechey, in his voyage to the Pacific, fell in with some natives of the Coral Islands, who had in a similar manner been carried to a great distance from their native country. They had embarked, to the number of 150 souls, in three double canoes, from Anaa, or Chain Island, situated about three hundred miles to the eastward of Otaheite. They were overtaken by the monsoon, which dispersed the canoes; and after driving them about the ocean, left them becalmed, so that a great number of persons perished. Two of the canoes were never heard of; but the other was drifted from one uninhabited island to another, at each of which the voyagers obtained a few provisions; and at length, after having wandered for a distance of 600 miles, they were found and carried to their home in the Blossom.945

Captain Beechey, during his journey to the Pacific, encountered some natives from the Coral Islands, who had also been taken far from their homeland. They had set out, about 150 people total, in three double canoes from Anaa, or Chain Island, located roughly three hundred miles east of Tahiti. They were caught by the monsoon, which scattered the canoes, and after being tossed around the ocean, they ended up stranded in calm waters, resulting in many people dying. Two of the canoes were never heard from again; however, the third was blown from one uninhabited island to another, where the travelers managed to find some food. Eventually, after drifting a distance of 600 miles, they were rescued and taken back home on the Blossom.945

Mr. Crawfurd informs me that there are several well-authenticated accounts of canoes having been drifted from Sumatra to Madagascar, and by such causes a portion of the Malayan language, with some useful plants, have been transferred to that island, which is principally peopled by negroes.

Mr. Crawfurd tells me that there are several reliable reports of canoes being carried from Sumatra to Madagascar, and as a result, some of the Malayan language and a few useful plants have made their way to that island, which is mainly inhabited by Black people.

The space traversed in some of these instances was so great, that similar accidents might suffice to transport canoes from various parts of Africa to the shores of South America, or from Spain to the Azores, and thence to North America; so that man, even in a rude state of society, is liable to be scattered involuntarily by the winds and waves over the globe, in a manner singularly analogous to that in which many plants and animals are diffused. We ought not, then, to wonder, that during the ages required for some tribes of the human race to attain that advanced stage of civilization which empowers the navigator to cross the ocean in all directions with security, the whole earth should 663 have become the abode of rude tribes of hunters and fishers. Were the whole of mankind now cut off, with the exception of one family, inhabiting the old or new continent, or Australia, or even some coral islet of the Pacific, we might expect their descendants, though they should never become more enlightened than the South Sea Islanders or the Esquimaux, to spread in the course of ages over the whole earth, diffused partly by the tendency of population to increase, in a limited district, beyond the means of subsistence, and partly by the accidental drifting of canoes by tides and currents to distant shores.

The distances traveled in some of these cases were so vast that similar incidents could easily move canoes from different parts of Africa to the shores of South America, or from Spain to the Azores, and then to North America. Thus, even in a primitive society, people can be unintentionally scattered across the globe by winds and waves, similar to how many plants and animals spread. We shouldn’t be surprised that over the long periods it took for some human tribes to reach a level of civilization that allows navigators to safely cross the ocean in all directions, the entire earth became home to primitive tribes of hunters and fishers. If all of humanity were suddenly to vanish except for one family living on the old or new continent, Australia, or even a small coral island in the Pacific, we would expect their descendants, even if they never became more advanced than the South Sea Islanders or the Eskimos, to populate the entire planet over the ages. This would happen partly because of the natural growth of the population in a restricted area beyond available resources, and partly due to the accidental drifting of canoes by tides and currents to far-off shores.

Involuntary Influence of Man in diffusing Animals and Plants.

Many of the general remarks which have been made respecting the influence of man in spreading or in checking the diffusion of plants apply equally to his relations with the animal kingdom. On a future occasion I shall be led to speak of the instrumentality of our species in naturalizing useful animals and plants in new regions, when explaining my views of the effects which the spreading and increase of certain species exert in the extirpation of others. At present I shall confine myself to a few remarks on the involuntary aid which man lends to the dissemination of species.

Many of the general comments made about how humans influence the spread or control the distribution of plants apply just as much to their interactions with the animal kingdom. In the future, I will discuss how our species plays a role in introducing useful animals and plants to new areas, particularly when I share my thoughts on how the spread and growth of certain species impact the extinction of others. For now, I will focus on a few thoughts about the unintentional assistance that humans provide in the spread of species.

In the mammiferous class our influence is chiefly displayed in increasing the number of quadrupeds which are serviceable to us, and in exterminating or reducing the number of those which are noxious.

In the mammal class, our influence mainly shows in increasing the number of four-legged animals that are helpful to us and in eliminating or reducing the number of those that are harmful.

Sometimes, however, we unintentionally promote the multiplication of inimical species, as when we introduced the rat, which was not indigenous in the new world, into all parts of America. They have been conveyed over in ships, and now infest a great multitude of islands and parts of that continent. In like manner the Norway rat (Mus decumanus) has been imported into England, where it plunders our property in ships and houses.

Sometimes, though, we accidentally encourage the spread of harmful species, like when we brought the rat, which wasn't native to the New World, to various places in America. They were transported on ships, and now they're everywhere on many islands and parts of the continent. Similarly, the Norway rat (Mus decumanus) has been brought to England, where it steals our belongings in ships and homes.

Among birds, the house sparrow may be cited as a species known to have extended its range with the tillage of the soil. During the last century it has spread gradually over Asiatic Russia towards the north and east, always following the progress of cultivation. It made its first appearance on the Irtisch in Tobolsk, soon after the Russians had ploughed the land. It came in 1735 up the Obi to Beresow, and four years after to Naryn, about fifteen degrees of longitude farther east. In 1710, it had been seen in the higher parts of the coast of the Lena, in the government of Irkutzk. In all these places it is now common, but is not yet found in the uncultivated regions of Kamtschatka.946

Among birds, the house sparrow is a species that has expanded its range due to farming. Over the last century, it has gradually spread across Asiatic Russia to the north and east, always following the growth of agriculture. It first appeared on the Irtisch in Tobolsk shortly after the Russians began plowing the land. In 1735, it moved up the Obi to Beresow, and four years later to Naryn, about fifteen degrees of longitude further east. It had been spotted in the higher parts of the coast of the Lena, in the Irkutsk region, back in 1710. In all these areas, it is now common, but it has yet to reach the uncultivated regions of Kamtschatka.946

The great viper (Fer de lance), a species no less venomous than the rattlesnake, which now ravages Martinique and St. Lucia, was accidentally introduced by man, and exists in no other part of the West Indies.

The great viper (Fer de lance), a species just as venomous as the rattlesnake, is now spreading in Martinique and St. Lucia after being accidentally brought in by humans, and it doesn’t exist anywhere else in the West Indies.

Many parasitic insects which attack our persons, and some of which are supposed to be peculiar to our species, have been carried into all parts 664 of the earth, and have as high a claim as man to a universal geographical distribution.

Many parasitic insects that attack us, and some that are believed to be unique to our species, have spread to every part of the world, and deserve as much recognition as humans for a universal geographical distribution. 664

A great variety of insects have been transported in ships from one country to another, especially in warmer latitudes. The European house-fly has been introduced in this way into all the South Sea Islands. Notwithstanding the coldness of our climate in England we have been unable to prevent the cockroach (Blatta orientalis) from entering and diffusing itself in our ovens and kneading troughs, and availing itself of the artificial warmth which we afford. It is well known also, that beetles, and many other kinds of ligniperdous insects, have been introduced into Great Britain in timber; especially several North American species. "The commercial relations," says Malte-Brun947, "between France and India have transported from the latter country the aphis, which destroys the apple tree, and two sorts of Neuroptera, the Lucifuga and Flavicola, mostly confined to Provence and the neighbourhood of Bourdeaux, where they devour the timber in the houses and naval arsenals."

A wide range of insects has been transported on ships from one country to another, especially in warmer regions. The European housefly has been introduced this way to all the South Sea Islands. Despite the cold climate in England, we haven't managed to stop the cockroach (Blatta orientalis) from getting into our ovens and mixing bowls, taking advantage of the artificial warmth we provide. It's also well known that beetles, along with many other types of wood-boring insects, have entered Great Britain through timber, particularly several species from North America. "The commercial relations," says Malte-Brun947, "between France and India have transported from India the aphis that destroys apple trees, as well as two types of Neuroptera, Lucifuga and Flavicola, which are mostly found in Provence and around Bordeaux, where they consume the timber in houses and naval arsenals."

Among mollusks we may mention the Teredo navalis, which is a native of equatorial seas, but which, by adhering to the bottom of ships, was transported to Holland, where it has been most destructive to vessels and piles. The same species has also become naturalized in England, and other countries enjoying an extensive commerce. Bulimus undatus, a land species of considerable size, native of Jamaica and other West Indian islands, has been imported, adhering to tropical timber, into Liverpool; and, as I learn from Mr. Broderip, is now naturalized in the woods near that town.

Among mollusks, we can mention the Teredo navalis, which is originally from equatorial seas but was brought to Holland by attaching itself to the bottoms of ships, where it has caused significant damage to vessels and wooden structures. This same species has also become established in England and other countries with extensive trade. The Bulimus undatus, a sizable land species native to Jamaica and other West Indian islands, has been brought into Liverpool by sticking to tropical timber; I learned from Mr. Broderip that it is now established in the woods near that town.

In all these and innumerable other instances we may regard the involuntary agency of man as strictly analogous to that of the inferior animals. Like them, we unconsciously contribute to extend or limit the geographical range and numbers of certain species, in obedience to general rules in the economy of nature, which are for the most part beyond our control.

In all these and countless other situations, we can see that human involuntary actions are very similar to those of lower animals. Like them, we unknowingly help to expand or restrict the geographical distribution and populations of certain species, following general rules in nature's system that are mostly beyond our control.


CHAPTER XL.

THEORIES RESPECTING THE ORIGINAL INTRODUCTION OF SPECIES.

Proposal of an hypothesis on this subject—Supposed centres or foci of creation—Why distinct provinces of animals and plants have not become more blended together—Brocchi's speculations on the loss of species—Stations of plants and animals—Causes on which they depend—Stations of plants how affected by animals—Equilibrium in the number of species how preserved—Peculiar efficacy of insects in this task—Rapidity with which certain insects multiply or decrease in numbers—Effect of omnivorous animals in preserving the equilibrium of species—Reciprocal influence of aquatic and terrestrial species on each other.

Proposal of a hypothesis on this topic—Supposed centers or foci of creation—Why different regions of animals and plants haven't mixed more—Brocchi's ideas on the extinction of species—Habitats of plants and animals—Factors that influence them—How plants' habitats are affected by animals—How the balance in the number of species is maintained—The unique role of insects in this process—How quickly certain insects reproduce or decline in numbers—The impact of omnivorous animals in maintaining the balance of species—The mutual influence of aquatic and terrestrial species on one another.

Theory of Linnæus.—It would be superfluous to examine the various attempts which were made to explain the phenomena of the distribution of species alluded to in the preceding chapters, in the infancy of the sciences of botany, zoology, and physical geography. The theories or rather conjectures then indulged now stand refuted by a simple statement of facts; and if Linnæus were living he would be the first to renounce the notions which he promulgated. For he imagined the habitable world to have been for a certain time limited to one small tract, the only portion of the earth's surface that was as yet laid bare by the subsidence of the primæval ocean. In this fertile spot he supposed the originals of all the species of plants which exist on this globe to have been congregated together with the first ancestors of all animals and of the human race. "In quâ commodè habitaverint animalia omnia, et vegetabilia lætè germinaverint." In order to accommodate the various habitudes of so many creatures, and to provide a diversity of climate suited to their several natures, the tract in which the creation took place was supposed to have been situated in some warm region of the earth, but to have contained a lofty mountain range, on the heights and in the declivities of which were to be found all temperatures and every climate, from that of the torrid to that of the frozen zone.948

Theory of Linnæus.—It would be unnecessary to go over the different efforts that were made to explain the patterns of species distribution mentioned in the earlier chapters during the early days of botany, zoology, and physical geography. The theories, or rather guesses, from that time have now been disproven by straightforward facts; and if Linnæus were alive today, he would be the first to reject the ideas he put forward. He believed that the habitable world was originally limited to a small area, the only part of the Earth's surface revealed by the receding primordial ocean. In this fertile region, he thought all the original species of plants on our planet were gathered along with the first ancestors of all animals and humans. "In quâ commodè habitaverint animalia omnia, et vegetabilia lætè germinaverint." To cater to the various habits of so many creatures and to provide a range of climates suitable for their different natures, this region of creation was thought to be located in a warm part of the Earth, but it was also believed to have a tall mountain range where all temperatures and climates could be found, from the hot zone to the frozen zone.948

That there never was a universal ocean since the planet was inhabited, or, rather, since the oldest groups of strata yet known to contain organic remains were formed, is proved by the presence of terrestrial plants or by indications of shores in all the older formations; and if this conclusion was not established, yet no geologist could deny that, since the first small portion of the earth was laid dry, there have been many entire changes in the species of plants and animals inhabiting the land.

That there has never been a universal ocean since the planet became inhabited, or since the oldest layers of rock known to contain organic remains formed, is demonstrated by the presence of land plants or signs of shorelines in all older formations. Even if this conclusion hasn't been completely proven, no geologist could argue against the fact that since the first small portion of the earth was exposed, there have been many complete changes in the species of plants and animals living on land.

But, without dwelling on the above and other refuted theories, let us inquire whether some hypothesis cannot be substituted as simple as that of Linnæus, to which the phenomena now ascertained in regard to the distribution both of aquatic and terrestrial species may be referred. 666 The following may, perhaps, be reconcileable with known facts:—Each species may have had its origin in a single pair, or individual, where an individual was sufficient, and species may have been created in succession at such times and in such places as to enable them to multiply and endure for an appointed period, and occupy an appointed space on the globe.

But instead of focusing on the theories we've already dismissed, let's consider if we can propose a hypothesis as straightforward as Linnæus's, to which the observed phenomena regarding the distribution of both aquatic and terrestrial species might be linked. 666 The following might be in line with established facts: Each species may have originated from a single pair or individual when one individual was enough, and species may have been created one after the other at specific times and locations to allow them to reproduce and survive for a designated period, and to inhabit a certain area on the planet.

In order to explain this theory, let us suppose every living thing to be destroyed in the western hemisphere, both on the land and in the ocean, and permission to be given to man to people this great desert, by transporting into it animals and plants from the eastern hemisphere, a strict prohibition being enforced against introducing two original stocks of the same species.

In order to explain this theory, let’s imagine that every living thing is wiped out in the western hemisphere, both on land and in the ocean, and man is allowed to repopulate this vast empty area by bringing in animals and plants from the eastern hemisphere, with a strict ban on introducing two original types of the same species.

Now it is easy to show that the result of such a mode of colonizing would correspond exactly, so far as regards the grouping of animals and plants, with that now observed throughout the globe. In the first place, it would be necessary for naturalists, before they imported species into particular localities, to study attentively the climate and other physical conditions of each spot. It would be no less requisite to introduce the different species in succession, so that each plant and animal might have time and opportunity to multiply before the species destined to prey upon it was admitted. Many herbs and shrubs, for example, must spread far and wide before the sheep, the deer, and the goat could be allowed to enter, lest they should devour and annihilate the original stocks of many plants, and then perish themselves for want of food. The above-mentioned herbivorous animals in their turn must be permitted to make considerable progress before the entrance of the first pair of wolves or lions. Insects must be allowed to swarm before the swallow could be permitted to skim through the air, and feast on thousands at one repast.

Now it’s easy to show that the way of colonizing described would match perfectly, at least in terms of how animals and plants are grouped, with what we currently see around the world. First, it would be necessary for naturalists to carefully study the climate and physical conditions of each area before introducing species. It would also be essential to introduce different species one after the other, so that each plant and animal has time to multiply before the species that will prey on them is brought in. For instance, many herbs and shrubs need to spread widely before sheep, deer, and goats are allowed in, to avoid them eating up and wiping out the original plants, which would leave them with no food and cause them to die off. Those herbivorous animals must also be given enough time to establish themselves before the first pair of wolves or lions is introduced. Insects should be allowed to thrive before swallows are permitted to swoop through the air and feast on thousands in one meal.

It is evident that, however equally in this case our original stocks were distributed over the whole surface of land and water, there would nevertheless arise distinct botanical and zoological provinces, for there are a great many natural barriers which oppose common obstacles to the advance of a variety of species. Thus, for example, almost all the animals and plants naturalized by us, towards the extremity of South America, would be unable to spread beyond a certain limit, towards the east, west, and south; because they would be stopped by the ocean, and a few of them only would succeed in reaching the cooler latitudes of the northern hemisphere, because they would be incapable of bearing the heat of the tropics, through which they must pass. In the course of ages, undoubtedly, exceptions would arise, and some species might become common to the temperate and polar regions, or both sides of the equator; for I have before shown that the powers of diffusion conferred on some classes are very great. But we might confidently predict that these exceptions would never become so numerous as to invalidate the general rule.

It's clear that even if our original species were evenly spread across all land and water, distinct botanical and zoological regions would still emerge. There are many natural barriers that hinder the movement of different species. For instance, almost all the animals and plants we introduced to the southern tip of South America wouldn't be able to spread beyond a certain point to the east, west, and south; they would be blocked by the ocean. Only a few might make it to the cooler areas of the northern hemisphere because they wouldn't survive the tropical heat they'd need to cross. Over time, there would definitely be exceptions, and some species could become common in both temperate and polar areas, or on either side of the equator; as I've noted before, some groups have significant abilities to spread. However, we can confidently say that these exceptions will never be so numerous that they overturn the general pattern.

Some of the plants and animals transplanted by us to the coast of Chili and Peru would never be able to cross the Andes, so as to reach 667 the eastern plains; nor, for a similar reason, would those first established in the Pampas, or the valleys of the Amazon and the Orinoco, ever arrive at the shores of the Pacific.

Some of the plants and animals we brought to the coast of Chile and Peru would never be able to cross the Andes to reach the eastern plains; and for the same reason, those that first took root in the Pampas or the valleys of the Amazon and the Orinoco would never make it to the shores of the Pacific.

In the ocean an analogous state of things would prevail; for there, also, climate would exert a great influence in limiting the range of species, and the land would stop the migrations of aquatic tribes as effectually as the sea arrests the dispersion of the terrestrial. As certain birds, insects, and the seeds of plants, can never cross the direction of prevailing winds, so currents form natural barriers to the dissemination of many oceanic races. A line of shoals may be as impassable to deep-water species, as are the Alps and the Andes to plants and animals peculiar to plains; while deep abysses may prove insuperable obstacles to the migrations of the inhabitants of shallow waters.

In the ocean, a similar situation would exist; because there, too, climate would play a significant role in limiting the range of species, and land would block the migrations of aquatic communities just as effectively as the sea prevents the spread of land species. Just as certain birds, insects, and plant seeds can’t overcome the direction of prevailing winds, ocean currents create natural barriers to the distribution of many marine species. A line of shallow waters can be just as impenetrable to deep-water species as the Alps and the Andes are to plants and animals that are native to plains; meanwhile, deep ocean trenches might act as insurmountable challenges to the migration of species living in shallower waters.

Supposed centres, or foci, of creation.—It is worthy of observation, that one effect of the introduction of single pairs of each species must be the confined range of certain groups in spots, which, like small islands, or solitary inland lakes, have few means of interchanging their inhabitants with adjoining regions. Now this congregating in a small space of many peculiar species, would give an appearance of centres or foci of creation, as they have been termed, as if they were favourite points where the creative energy has been in greater action than in others, and where the numbers of peculiar organic beings have consequently become more considerable.

Supposed centers, or foci, of creation.—It's worth noting that one effect of introducing single pairs of each species is the limited range of certain groups in locations that, like small islands or isolated inland lakes, have few ways of exchanging their inhabitants with neighboring areas. Now, this gathering of many unique species in a small space would create the impression of centers or foci of creation, as they have been called, as if these were favored spots where creative energy has been more active than in other places, resulting in a greater number of unique living beings.

I do not mean to call in question the soundness of the inferences of some botanists, as to the former existence of certain limited spots whence species of plants have been propagated, radiating, as it were, in all directions from a common centre. On the contrary, I conceive these phenomena to be the necessary consequences of the plan of nature before suggested, operating during the successive mutations of the surface, some of which the geologist can prove to have taken place subsequently to the period when many species now existing were created. In order to exemplify how this arrangement of plants may have been produced, let us imagine that, about three centuries before the discovery of St. Helena (itself of submarine volcanic origin), a multitude of new islands had been thrown up in the surrounding sea, and that these had each become clothed with plants emigrating from St. Helena, in the same manner as the wild plants of Campania have diffused themselves over Monte Nuovo. Whenever the first botanist investigated the new archipelago, he would, in all probability, find a different assemblage of plants in each of the islands of recent formation; but in St. Helena itself, he would meet with individuals of every species, belonging to all parts of the archipelago, and some, in addition, peculiar to itself, viz., those which had not been able to obtain a passage into any one of the surrounding new-formed lands. In this case it might be truly said that the original island was the primitive focus, or centre, of a certain type of vegetation; whereas, in the surrounding islands, there would be a smaller number of species, yet all belonging to the same group.

I don’t mean to question the validity of some botanists’ conclusions about the previous existence of specific limited areas from which plant species spread out in all directions from a common center. On the contrary, I believe these phenomena are necessary results of the natural plan previously suggested, operating during the successive changes on the Earth's surface, some of which geologists can prove occurred after the time when many of the currently existing species were created. To illustrate how this arrangement of plants might have come about, let’s imagine that, about three centuries before the discovery of St. Helena (which itself is of volcanic origin), a number of new islands had risen from the surrounding sea, and that these islands had each become populated with plants migrating from St. Helena, similar to how the wild plants of Campania have spread over Monte Nuovo. Whenever the first botanist explored the new archipelago, he would likely find a different mix of plants on each of the newly formed islands; however, on St. Helena itself, he would encounter individuals of every species from all parts of the archipelago, along with some unique to the island, specifically those that couldn’t reach any of the surrounding new islands. In this scenario, it could truly be said that the original island was the primary center of a certain type of vegetation; whereas, in the surrounding islands, there would be fewer species, but all belonging to the same group.

668 But this peculiar distribution of plants would not warrant the conclusion that, in the space occupied by St. Helena, there had been a greater exertion of creative power than in the spaces of equal area occupied by the new adjacent lands; because, within the period in which St. Helena had acquired its peculiar vegetation, each of the spots supposed to be subsequently converted into land may have been the birth-place of a great number of marine animals and plants, which may have had time to scatter themselves far and wide over the southern Atlantic.

668 However, the unique distribution of plants doesn’t mean that St. Helena experienced more creative power than the nearby lands of the same size. During the time St. Helena developed its distinct vegetation, each of the areas that were later transformed into land might have been home to many marine animals and plants, which could have spread out widely across the southern Atlantic.

Why distinct provinces not more blended.—Perhaps it may be objected to some parts of the foregoing train of reasoning, that during the lapse of past ages, especially during many partial revolutions of the globe of comparatively modern date, different zoological and botanical provinces ought to have become more confounded and blended together—that the distribution of species approaches too nearly to what might have been expected, if animals and plants had been introduced into the globe when its physical geography had already assumed the features which it now wears; whereas we know that, in certain districts, considerable geographical changes have taken place since species identical with those now in being were created.

Why distinct provinces are not more blended.—Some might argue against parts of the earlier reasoning, suggesting that over the ages, particularly during various recent changes in the Earth, different zoological and botanical provinces should have become more mixed and integrated. They may point out that the distribution of species is too close to what we would expect if animals and plants had been introduced to the Earth after its physical geography had taken on its current form. However, we know that in certain areas, significant geographical changes have occurred since species identical to those that exist today were created.

Brocchi's speculations on loss of species.—These and many kindred topics cannot be fully discussed until we have considered, not merely the general laws which may regulate the first introduction of species, but those which may limit their duration on the earth. Brocchi remarked, when hazarding some interesting conjectures respecting "the loss of species," that a modern naturalist had no small assurance, who declared "that individuals alone were capable of destruction, and that species were so perpetuated that nature could not annihilate them, so long as the planet lasted, or at least that nothing less than the shock of a comet, or some similar disaster, could put an end to their existence."949 The Italian geologist, on the contrary, had satisfied himself that many species of Testacea, which formerly inhabited the Mediterranean, had become extinct, although a great number of others, which had been the contemporaries of those lost races, still survived. He came to the opinion that about half the species which peopled the waters when the Subapennine strata were deposited had gone out of existence; and in this inference he does not appear to have been far wrong.

Brocchi's thoughts on species loss.—These and many related topics can't be fully explored until we look at not just the general laws that might govern the initial introduction of species, but also those that might limit their duration on Earth. Brocchi noted, while making some intriguing predictions about "the loss of species," that a modern naturalist had quite a bit of confidence when he claimed "that only individuals can be destroyed, and that species endure so long that nature cannot eliminate them as long as the planet exists, or at least that only the impact of a comet, or another similar disaster, could bring an end to their existence." 949 The Italian geologist, however, believed that many species of Testacea that once lived in the Mediterranean had gone extinct, even though many others that existed at the same time as those lost species were still around. He estimated that about half of the species that filled the waters when the Subapennine layers were formed had disappeared; and in this conclusion, he seems to have been quite accurate.

But, instead of seeking a solution of this problem; like some other geologists of his time, in a violent and general catastrophe, Brocchi endeavoured to imagine some regular and constant law by which species might be made to disappear from the earth gradually and in succession. The death, he suggested, of a species might depend, like that of individuals, on certain peculiarities of constitution conferred upon them at their birth; and as the longevity of the one depends on a certain force of vitality, which, after a period, grows weaker and weaker, so the duration of the other may be governed by the quantity of prolific power 669 bestowed upon the species which, after a season, may decline in energy, so that the fecundity and multiplication of individuals may be gradually lessened from century to century, "until that fatal term arrives when the embryo, incapable of extending and developing itself, abandons, almost at the instant of its formation, the slender principle of life by which it was scarcely animated,—and so all dies with it."

But instead of trying to find a solution to this problem, like some other geologists of his time who believed in a violent and widespread catastrophe, Brocchi aimed to develop a consistent and regular principle explaining how species could gradually and sequentially disappear from the Earth. He proposed that the extinction of a species might be influenced, similar to individual deaths, by specific traits assigned to them at birth; and just as the lifespan of an individual hinges on a certain level of vitality that diminishes over time, the lifespan of a species might depend on its reproductive capacity, which could decrease in strength after a period. This means that the ability to reproduce and the growth of individuals could steadily decline from century to century, "until that fatal moment arrives when the embryo, unable to grow and develop, relinquishes, almost at the moment of its formation, the fragile spark of life by which it was barely animated—and thus all dies with it."

Now we may coincide in opinion with the Italian naturalist, as to the gradual extinction of species one after another, by the operation of regular and constant causes, without admitting an inherent principle of deterioration in their physiological attributes. We might concede, "that many species are on the decline, and that the day is not far distant when they will cease to exist;" yet deem it consistent with what we know of the nature of organic beings, to believe that the last individuals of each species retain their prolific powers in their full intensity.

Now we might agree with the Italian naturalist about the gradual extinction of species one after another, caused by consistent and regular factors, without accepting an inherent principle of deterioration in their biological traits. We could acknowledge, "that many species are declining, and that the day is coming when they will no longer exist;" yet it makes sense, based on what we understand about the nature of living organisms, to believe that the last individuals of each species still possess their reproductive abilities at full strength.

Brocchi has himself speculated on the share which a change of climate may have had in rendering the Mediterranean unfit for the habitation of certain Testacea, which still continued to thrive in the Indian Ocean, and of others which were now only represented by analogous forms within the tropics. He must also have been aware that other extrinsic causes, such as the progress of human population, or the increase of some one of the inferior animals, might gradually lead to the extirpation of a particular species, although its fecundity might remain to the last unimpaired. If, therefore, amid the vicissitudes of the animate and inanimate world, there are known causes capable of bringing about the decline and extirpation of species, it became him thoroughly to investigate the full extent to which these might operate, before he speculated on any cause of so purely hypothetical a kind as "the diminution of the prolific virtue."

Brocchi has considered how a change in climate might have made the Mediterranean unsuitable for certain shellfish, which continued to thrive in the Indian Ocean, while others were only found in different forms in tropical regions. He must have also recognized that other external factors, like the growth of the human population or the rise of certain other animals, could gradually lead to the extinction of a specific species, even if its ability to reproduce remained strong until the end. Therefore, in the midst of the changes in both living and non-living things, there are known factors that can cause the decline and extinction of species. It was necessary for him to thoroughly investigate how much these factors might be at play before he proposed any purely hypothetical cause like "the decrease in reproductive capacity."

If it could have been shown that some wild plant had insensibly dwindled away and died out, as sometimes happens to cultivated varieties propagated by cuttings, even though climate, soil, and every other circumstance, should continue identically the same—if any animal had perished while the physical condition of the earth, and the number and force of its foes, with every other extrinsic cause, remain unaltered, then might we have some ground for suspecting that the infirmities of age creep on as naturally on species as upon individuals. But, in the absence of such observations, let us turn to another class of facts, and examine attentively the circumstances which determine the stations of particular animals and plants, and perhaps we shall discover, in the vicissitudes to which these stations are exposed, a cause fully adequate to explain the phenomena under consideration.

If it could be shown that some wild plant had gradually disappeared and gone extinct, like sometimes happens with cultivated varieties grown from cuttings, even if the climate, soil, and all other factors remained exactly the same—if any animal had died while the physical conditions of the earth, the number and strength of its predators, and every other external cause stayed the same—then we might have some reason to suspect that the weaknesses of age affect species just like they do individuals. But, without such evidence, let’s look at a different set of facts and closely examine the factors that determine the habitats of specific animals and plants, and maybe we’ll find that the changes these habitats experience provide an adequate explanation for the phenomena we’re considering.

Stations of plants and animals.—Stations comprehend all the circumstances, whether relating to the animate or inanimate world, which determine whether a given plant or animal can exist in a given place; so that if it be shown that stations can become essentially modified by the influence of known causes, it will follow that species, as well as individuals, are mortal.

Stations of plants and animals.—Stations include all the conditions, whether linked to living or non-living things, that affect whether a specific plant or animal can survive in a particular location; therefore, if it is demonstrated that stations can change significantly due to known factors, it will mean that both species and individuals are subject to mortality.

Every naturalist is familiar with the fact, that although in a particular 670 country, such as Great Britain, there may be more than three thousand species of plants, ten thousand insects, and a great variety in each of the other classes; yet there will not be more than a hundred, perhaps not half that number, inhabiting any given locality. There may be no want of space in the supposed tract: it may be a large mountain, or an extensive moor, or a great river plain, containing room enough for individuals of every species in our island; yet the spot will be occupied by a few to the exclusion of many, and these few are enabled, throughout long periods, to maintain their ground successfully against every intruder, notwithstanding the facilities which species enjoy, by virtue of their power of diffusion, of invading adjacent territories.

Every naturalist knows that in a specific country, like Great Britain, there can be over three thousand species of plants, ten thousand insects, and a wide variety of other classes; however, in any given area, there might only be about a hundred species, or even less than that. There might be plenty of space in the area in question: it could be a large mountain, a vast moor, or an expansive river plain, all having enough room for every species found in our island; yet, the area ends up being filled by just a few species that successfully hold their ground over long periods against any newcomers, despite the advantages species have in spreading and invading neighboring areas.

The principal causes which enable a certain assemblage of plants thus to maintain their ground against all others depend, as is well known, on the relations between the physiological nature of each species, and the climate, exposure, soil, and other physical conditions of the locality. Some plants live only on rocks, others in meadows, a third class in marshes. Of the latter, some delight in a fresh-water morass,—others in salt marshes, where their roots may copiously absorb saline particles. Some prefer an alpine region in a warm latitude, where, during the heat of summer, they are constantly irrigated by the cool waters of melting snows. To others loose sand, so fatal to the generality of species, affords the most proper station. The Carex arenaria and the Elymus arenarius acquire their full vigor on a sandy dune, obtaining an ascendancy over the very plants which in a stiff clay would immediately stifle them.

The main reasons why certain groups of plants can thrive despite competition from others are well-known. They depend on the relationships between each species' physiological traits and the local climate, exposure, soil, and other physical conditions. Some plants can only survive on rocks, others in meadows, and a third group in marshes. Of those in marshes, some prefer fresh-water bogs, while others thrive in salt marshes, where their roots can absorb saline particles. Some plants favor alpine regions in warm climates, where they stay hydrated during summer from the cool waters of melting snow. For some, loose sand, which is usually harmful to many species, is the ideal environment. The Carex arenaria and the Elymus arenarius reach their full potential on sandy dunes, dominating over plants that would smother them in dense clay.

Where the soil of a district is of so peculiar a nature that it is extremely favorable to certain species, and agrees ill with every other, the former get exclusive possession of the ground, and, as in the case of heaths, live in societies. In like manner the bog moss (Sphagnum) is fully developed in peaty swamps, and becomes, like the heath, in the language of botanists, a social plant. Such monopolies, however, are not common, for they are checked by various causes. Not only are many species endowed with equal powers to obtain and keep possession of similar stations, but each plant, for reasons not fully explained by the physiologist, has the property of rendering the soil where it has grown less fitted for the support of other individuals of its own species, or even other species of the same family. Yet the same spot, so far from being impoverished, is improved, for plants of another family. Oaks, for example, render the soil more fertile for the fir tribe, and firs prepare the soil for oaks. Every agriculturist feels the force of this law of the organic world, and regulates accordingly the rotation of his crops.

Where the soil in an area has such unique characteristics that it’s extremely suited to certain species and doesn’t work well for others, the favored species dominate the land and, like heaths, form communities. Similarly, bog moss (Sphagnum) thrives in peaty swamps, becoming, like heath, what botanists call a social plant. However, these monopolies are not common, as they are countered by various factors. Many species have equal abilities to take and maintain control of similar environments, and for reasons not yet fully understood by physiologists, each plant tends to make the soil it grows in less suitable for supporting other individuals of its own species or even other species within the same family. Yet, the same land, rather than becoming depleted, is improved for plants of another family. For example, oaks make the soil more fertile for firs, and firs prepare the soil for oaks. Every farmer understands this principle of the organic world and adjusts the rotation of their crops accordingly.

Equilibrium in the number of species, how preserved.—"All the plants of a given country," says De Candolle, in his usual spirited style, "are at war one with another. The first which establish themselves by chance in a particular spot tend, by the mere occupancy of space, to exclude other species—the greater choke the smaller; the longest livers replace those which last for a shorter period; the more prolific gradually make 671 themselves masters of the ground, which species multiplying more slowly would otherwise fill."

Equilibrium in the number of species, how preserved.—"All the plants in a specific country," states De Candolle, in his characteristic vibrant style, "are in competition with each other. The first ones that establish themselves by chance in a certain area tend, simply by occupying space, to push out other species—the larger ones overshadow the smaller; the longer-living plants replace those with shorter lifespans; the more fertile gradually take control of the ground that slower-multiplying species would otherwise occupy."

In this continual strife it is not always the resources of the plant itself which enable it to maintain or extend its ground. Its success depends, in a great measure, on the number of its foes or allies among the animals and plants inhabiting the same region. Thus, for example, a herb which loves the shade may multiply, if some tree with spreading boughs and dense foliage flourish in the neighborhood. Another, which, if unassisted, would be overpowered by the rank growth of some hardy competitor, is secure because its leaves are unpalatable to cattle; which, on the other hand, annually crop down its antagonist, and rarely suffer it to ripen its seed.

In this ongoing struggle, it's not just the plant's own resources that allow it to hold or expand its territory. Its success largely depends on the number of enemies or friends among the animals and plants in the same area. For instance, a herb that thrives in the shade can thrive if there's a tree with wide branches and thick leaves nearby. Another plant, which would be overwhelmed by a strong competitor without help, is safe because its leaves taste bad to cattle, which, on the flip side, regularly eat its rival and seldom let it produce seeds.

Oftentimes we see some herb which has flowered in the midst of a thorny shrub, when all the other individuals of the same species, in the open fields around, are eaten down, and cannot bring their seed to maturity. In this case, the shrub has lent his armor of spines and prickles to protect the defenceless herb against the mouths of the cattle, and thus a few individuals which occupied, perhaps, the most unfavorable station in regard to exposure, soil, and other circumstances, may, nevertheless, by the aid of an ally, become the principal source whereby the winds are supplied with seeds which perpetuate the species throughout the surrounding tract. Thus, in the New Forest in Hampshire, the young oaks which are not consumed by the deer, or uprooted by the swine, are indebted to the holly for their escape.

Often, we notice a herb that has bloomed in the middle of a thorny bush while all the other members of that species in the open fields nearby are eaten away and can't produce seeds. In this case, the shrub protects the vulnerable herb with its spines and prickles against grazing animals. As a result, a few individuals that were in perhaps the least favorable spots concerning exposure, soil, and other conditions can still thrive, thanks to their ally, and become the main source of seeds carried by the wind that help perpetuate the species in the surrounding area. For instance, in the New Forest in Hampshire, the young oaks that aren't eaten by deer or uprooted by pigs owe their survival to the holly.

In the above examples we see one plant shielding another from the attacks of animals; but instances are, perhaps, still more numerous, where some animal defends a plant against the enmity of some other subject of the vegetable kingdom.

In the examples above, we see one plant protecting another from animal attacks; however, there are probably even more cases where an animal defends a plant from the hostility of another species in the plant kingdom.

Scarcely any beast, observes a Swedish naturalist, will touch the nettle, but fifty different kinds of insects are fed by it.950 Some of these seize upon the root, others upon the stem; some eat the leaves, others devour the seeds and flowers; but for this multitude of enemies, the nettle (Urtica dioica), which is now found in all the four quarters of the globe, would annihilate a great number of plants. Linnæus tells us, in his "Tour in Scania," that goats were turned into an island which abounded with the Agrostis arundinacea, where they perished by famine; but horses which followed them grew fat on the same plant. The goat, also, he says, thrives on the meadow-sweet and water-hemlock, plants which are injurious to cattle.951

Scarcely any animal, notes a Swedish naturalist, will touch the nettle, but fifty different types of insects feed on it.950 Some of these attack the root, others the stem; some eat the leaves, while others consume the seeds and flowers. Without this multitude of enemies, the nettle (Urtica dioica), which is now found across the globe, could eliminate a lot of plants. Linnæus mentions in his "Tour in Scania" that goats were brought onto an island rich in Agrostis arundinacea, where they starved to death; however, the horses that followed thrived on the same plant. He also notes that the goat does well on meadow-sweet and water-hemlock, plants that are harmful to cattle.951

Agency of insects.—Every plant, observes Wilcke, has its proper insect allotted to it to curb its luxuriancy, and to prevent it from multiplying to the exclusion of others. "Thus grass in meadows sometimes flourishes so as to exclude all other plants; here the Phalæna graminis (Bombyx gram.), with her numerous progeny, finds a well-spread table; 672 they multiply in immense numbers, and the farmer, for some years, laments the failure of his crop; but the grass being consumed, the moths die with hunger, or remove to another place. Now the quantity of grass being greatly diminished, the other plants, which were before choked by it, spring up, and the ground becomes variegated with a multitude of different species of flowers. Had not nature given a commission to this minister for that purpose, the grass would destroy a great number of species of vegetables, of which the equilibrium is now kept up."952

Agency of insects.—Every plant, as Wilcke notes, has its specific insect assigned to it to control its growth and prevent it from dominating others. "For instance, grass in meadows can sometimes thrive so much that it crowds out all other plants; here, the Phalæna graminis (Bombyx gram.), with her numerous offspring, finds a plentiful feast; 672 they reproduce in huge numbers, causing the farmer to lament the failure of his crop for several years; but once the grass is consumed, the moths starve or migrate to another area. With the grass significantly reduced, the other plants that were previously overshadowed begin to flourish, turning the ground into a colorful array of various flower species. Had nature not assigned this insect for that purpose, the grass would have wiped out many varieties of plants, which are now kept in balance." 952

In the above passage allusion is made to the ravages committed in 1740, and the two following years, in many provinces of Sweden, by a most destructive insect. The same moth is said never to touch the foxtail grass, so that it may be classed as a most active ally and benefactor of that species, and as peculiarly instrumental in preserving it in its present abundance.953 A discovery of Rolander, cited in the treatise of Wilcke above mentioned, affords a good illustration of the checks and counter-checks which nature has appointed to preserve the balance of power among species. "The Phalæna strobilella has the fir cone assigned to it to deposit its eggs upon; the young caterpillars coming out of the shell consume the cone and superfluous seed; but, lest the destruction should be too general, the Ichneumon strobilellæ lays its eggs in the caterpillar, inserting its long tail in the openings of the cone till it touches the included insect, for its body is too large to enter. Thus it fixes its minute egg upon the caterpillar, which being hatched, destroys it."954

In the above passage, there’s a reference to the devastation caused in 1740 and the following two years by a highly destructive insect in many regions of Sweden. It is said that this moth never affects foxtail grass, making it a vital ally and protector of that species, particularly in helping to maintain its current abundance.953 A discovery by Rolander, mentioned in the treatise by Wilcke, illustrates the checks and balances that nature has established to maintain the equilibrium among species. "The Phalæna strobilella uses the fir cone to lay its eggs; the young caterpillars that emerge consume the cone and excess seeds. However, to prevent widespread destruction, the Ichneumon strobilellæ lays its eggs in the caterpillar by inserting its long tail into the openings of the cone until it reaches the caterpillar, since its body is too large to enter. It then deposits its tiny egg on the caterpillar, which, once hatched, destroys it."954

Entomologists enumerate many parallel cases where insects, appropriated to certain plants, are kept down by other insects, and these again by parasites expressly appointed to prey on them.955 Few perhaps are in the habit of duly appreciating the extent to which insects are active in preserving the balance of species among plants, and thus regulating indirectly the relative numbers of many of the higher orders of terrestrial animals.

Entomologists list many similar instances where insects that feed on specific plants are kept in check by other insects, which in turn are controlled by parasites specifically designed to prey on them.955 Few people likely recognize how much insects contribute to maintaining the balance of species among plants, thereby indirectly regulating the populations of many higher-order terrestrial animals.

The peculiarity of their agency consists in their power of suddenly multiplying their numbers to a degree which could only be accomplished in a considerable lapse of time in any of the larger animals, and then as instantaneously relapsing, without the intervention of any violent disturbing cause, into their former insignificance.

The unique aspect of their agency is their ability to quickly increase their numbers to a level that would usually take a long time for larger animals to achieve, and then just as suddenly return to their previous small size, without the need for any major disruptive cause.

If, for the sake of employing, on different but rare occasions, a power of many hundred horses, we were under the necessity of feeding all these animals at great cost in the intervals when their services were not required, we should greatly admire the invention of a machine, such as the steam-engine, which was capable at any moment of exerting the same degree of strength without any consumption of food during periods of inaction. The same kind of admiration is strongly excited when we contemplate the powers of insect life, in the creation of which the Author 673 of nature has been so prodigal. A scanty number of minute individuals, to be detected only by careful research, are ready in a few days, weeks, or months, to give birth to myriads, which may repress any degree of monopoly in another species, or remove nuisances, such as dead carcases, which might taint the air. But no sooner has the destroying commission been executed than the gigantic power becomes dormant—each of the mighty host soon reaches the term of its transient existence, and the season arrives when the whole species passes naturally into the egg, and thence into the larva and pupa state. In this defenceless condition it may be destroyed either by the elements, or by the augmentation of some of its numerous foes which may prey upon it in the early stages of its transformation: or it often happens that in the following year the season proves unfavorable to the hatching of the eggs or the development of the pupæ.

If, for the sake of occasionally using a powerful engine with many hundreds of horsepower, we had to feed all these animals at a great expense during the times when they weren't needed, we would really appreciate the invention of a machine like the steam engine, which can deliver the same amount of power at any moment without consuming food during downtime. We feel a similar admiration when we think about the capabilities of insect life, which the Creator of nature has been so generous in producing. A small number of tiny creatures, only identifiable through careful observation, can quickly give rise to thousands in a matter of days, weeks, or months, potentially suppressing any monopolies from other species or eliminating nuisances like dead bodies that could pollute the air. But as soon as their task of destruction is completed, the massive population becomes inactive—each of these powerful beings soon reaches the end of its brief life, and then comes the time when the entire species naturally transitions into eggs, then into larvae and pupae. In this vulnerable state, they can be wiped out by the elements or by an increase in their many enemies that prey on them during the early stages of their transformation; or it often happens that in the following year, the conditions turn out to be unfavorable for the eggs to hatch or the pupae to develop.

Thus the swarming myriads depart which may have covered the vegetation like the aphides, or darkened the air like locusts. In almost every season there are some species which in this manner put forth their strength, and then, like Milton's spirits, which thronged the spacious hall, "reduce to smallest forms their shapes immense"—

Thus the countless swarms leave, which could have covered the plants like aphids or blackened the sky like locusts. Almost every season, there are some species that exert their strength in this way, and then, like Milton's spirits that filled the vast hall, "shrink to tiny forms their enormous shapes"—

So thick the airy crowd Swarmed and were crowded until the signal was given, Look at this amazing sight! They just appeared, but who seemed... To be bigger than the giants of the earth, Now smaller than the smallest dwarfs.

A few examples will illustrate the mode in which this force operates. It is well known that, among the countless species of the insect creation, some feed on animal, others on vegetable matter; and upon considering a catalogue of eight thousand British Insects and Arachnidæ, Mr. Kirby found that these two divisions were nearly a counterpoise to each other, the carnivorous being somewhat preponderant. There are also distinct species, some appointed to consume living, others dead or putrid animal and vegetable substances. One female, of Musca carnaria, will give birth to twenty thousand young; and the larvæ of many flesh-flies devour so much food in twenty-four hours, and grow so quickly, as to increase their weight two hundred-fold! In five days after being hatched they arrive at their full growth and size, so that there was ground, says Kirby, for the assertion of Linnæus, that three flies of M. vomitoria could devour a dead horse as quickly as a lion956; and another Swedish naturalist remarks, that so great are the powers of propagation of a single species even of the smallest insects, that each can commit, when required, more ravages than the elephant.957

A few examples will show how this force works. It's well known that, among the countless species of insects, some feed on animals while others feed on plants. When looking at a list of eight thousand British insects and arachnids, Mr. Kirby found that these two groups almost balance each other out, with carnivorous insects slightly in the lead. There are also specific species, some designed to consume living organisms and others that break down dead or decaying animal and plant matter. One female of Musca carnaria can produce twenty thousand young; and the larvae of many flesh-flies eat so much in just twenty-four hours and grow so fast that they can increase their weight two hundred times! Within five days of hatching, they reach their maximum size, which supports Linnæus's claim that three flies of M. vomitoria could consume a dead horse as fast as a lion956; and another Swedish naturalist points out that the reproductive power of even the smallest insects is so great that each can cause more destruction than an elephant when needed.957

Next to locusts, the aphides, perhaps, exert the greatest power over the vegetable world, and, like them, are so sometimes so numerous as to darken the air. The multiplication of these little creatures is without 674 parallel, and almost every plant has its peculiar species. Reaumur has proved that in five generations one aphis may be the progenitor of 5,904,900,000 descendants; and it is supposed that in one year there may be twenty generations.958 Mr. Curtis observes that, as among caterpillars we find some that are constantly and unalterably attached to one or more particular species of plants, and others that feed indiscriminately on most sorts of herbage, so it is precisely with the aphides: some are particular, others more general feeders; and as they resemble other insects in this respect, so they do also in being more abundant in some years than in others.959 In 1793 they were the chief, and in 1798 the sole, cause of the failure of the hops. In 1794, a season, almost unparalleled for drought, the hop was perfectly free from them; while peas and beans, especially the former, suffered very much from their depredations.

Next to locusts, aphids probably have the biggest impact on the plant world, and just like locusts, they can sometimes be so numerous that they darken the air. The rapid reproduction of these tiny creatures is unmatched, and nearly every plant has its own specific species. Reaumur demonstrated that in just five generations, one aphid can produce 5,904,900,000 descendants; it is believed that there can be twenty generations in a single year.674 Mr. Curtis notes that just as some caterpillars are always associated with one or more specific types of plants, while others tend to feed on various kinds of vegetation, the same applies to aphids: some are specialized feeders, while others are more general. Like other insects, aphids are more abundant in certain years than in others.958 In 1793, they were the main reason for the failure of hops, and in 1798, they were the only reason for it. In 1794, which was an extremely dry season, hops were completely free of them, while peas and beans, especially the former, suffered greatly from their damage.959

The ravages of the caterpillars of some of our smaller moths afford a good illustration of the temporary increase of a species. The oak-trees of a considerable wood have been stripped of their leaves as bare as in winter by the caterpillars of a small green moth (Tortrix viridana), which has been observed the year following not to abound.960 The silver Y moth (Plusia gamma), although one of our common species, is not dreaded by us for its devastations; but legions of their caterpillars have at times created alarm in France, as in 1735. Reaumur observes that the female moth lays about four hundred eggs; so that if twenty caterpillars were distributed in a garden, and all lived through the winter and became moths in the succeeding May, the eggs laid by these, if half of them were female and all fertile, would in the next generation produce 800,000 caterpillars.961 A modern writer, therefore, justly observes that, did not Providence put causes in operation to keep them in due bounds, the caterpillars of this moth alone, leaving out of consideration the two thousand other British species, might soon destroy more than half of our vegetation.962

The damage caused by the caterpillars of some of our smaller moths is a great example of how a species can temporarily explode in numbers. The oak trees in a large forest have been stripped of their leaves, looking as bare as they do in winter, by the caterpillars of a small green moth (Tortrix viridana), which has been seen to not be as abundant the following year.960 The silver Y moth (Plusia gamma), while common, isn’t feared for its destruction; however, swarms of their caterpillars have occasionally caused panic in France, such as in 1735. Reaumur notes that the female moth lays about four hundred eggs, so if twenty caterpillars were spread throughout a garden, and all survived the winter to become moths in the following May, the eggs laid by these would generate, assuming half were female and all fertile, 800,000 caterpillars in the next generation.961 A modern writer rightly points out that if it weren't for natural measures to keep them in check, the caterpillars of just this moth could quickly wipe out more than half of our plant life, not even considering the two thousand other British species.962

In the latter part of the last century an ant most destructive to the sugar-cane (Formica saccharivora), appeared in such infinite hosts in the island of Granada, as to put a stop to the cultivation of that vegetable. Their numbers were incredible. The plantations and roads were filled with them; many domestic quadrupeds, together with rats, mice, and reptiles, and even birds, perished in consequence of this plague. It was not till 1780 that they were at length annihilated by torrents of rain, which accompanied a dreadful hurricane.963

In the late part of the last century, an incredibly destructive ant species, Formica saccharivora, swarmed the island of Grenada in such huge numbers that it halted the cultivation of sugar cane. Their population was astonishing. The plantations and roads were overrun with them; many domestic animals, along with rats, mice, reptiles, and even birds, died due to this infestation. It wasn't until 1780 that they were finally wiped out by heavy rainstorms that came with a terrible hurricane.963

Devastations caused by locusts.—We may conclude by mentioning some instances of the devastations of locusts in various countries. Among other parts of Africa, Cyrenaica has been at different periods infested by myriads of these creatures, which have consumed nearly every green thing. The effect of the havoc committed by them may be estimated 675 by the famine they occasioned. St. Augustin mentions a plague of this kind in Africa, which destroyed no less than 800,000 men in the kingdom of Massinissa alone, and many more upon the territories bordering upon the sea. It is also related, that in the year 591 an infinite army of locusts migrated from Africa into Italy; and, after grievously ravaging the country, were cast into the sea, when there arose a pestilence from their stench, which carried off nearly a million of men and beasts.

Devastations caused by locusts.—We can conclude by highlighting some examples of the destruction caused by locusts in different countries. In various regions of Africa, Cyrenaica has, at different times, been plagued by swarms of these insects, which have devoured nearly all greenery. The extent of the destruction they caused can be measured by the resulting famine. St. Augustine mentions a similar plague in Africa that killed no less than 800,000 people in the kingdom of Massinissa alone, with many more perishing in the coastal areas. It is also noted that in the year 591, an enormous swarm of locusts migrated from Africa to Italy; after severely devastating the land, they were washed into the sea, which led to a pestilence from their rotting bodies that claimed nearly a million lives among humans and animals.

In the Venetian territory, also, in 1748, more than thirty thousand persons are said to have perished in a famine occasioned by this scourge; and other instances are recorded of their devastations in France, Spain, Italy, Germany, &c. In different parts of Russia also, Hungary, and Poland, in Arabia and India, and other countries, their visitations have been periodically experienced. Although they have a preference for certain plants, yet, when these are consumed, they will attack almost all the remainder. In the accounts of the invasion of locusts, the statements which appear most marvellous relate to the prodigious mass of matter which encumbers the sea wherever they are blown into it, and the pestilence arising from its putrefaction. Their dead bodies are said to have been, in some places, heaped one upon another, to the depth of four feet, in Russia, Poland and Lithuania; and when, in Southern Africa, they were driven into the sea, by a north-west wind, they formed, says Barrow, along the shore, for fifty miles, a bank three or four feet high.964 But when we consider that forests are stripped of their foliage, and the earth of its green garment for thousands of square miles, it may well be supposed that the volume of animal matter produced may equal that of great herds of quadrupeds and flights of large birds suddenly precipitated into the sea.

In the Venetian region, back in 1748, over thirty thousand people reportedly died in a famine caused by this disaster; there are also recorded instances of their destruction in France, Spain, Italy, Germany, and other places. Different areas of Russia, Hungary, Poland, as well as Arabia and India, and various other countries have also periodically experienced their invasions. Although they prefer certain plants, they will attack nearly all the others once their favorites are gone. The accounts of locust invasions often highlight the astonishing amounts of material that clutter the sea wherever they are blown in, as well as the disease caused by its decay. In some places, their dead bodies are said to have piled up to four feet deep in Russia, Poland, and Lithuania; and when they were pushed into the sea by a northwest wind in Southern Africa, they created, as Barrow notes, a bank three or four feet high along the shore for fifty miles. But when we consider that forests are stripped bare, and the land is left without its greenery across thousands of square miles, it's reasonable to think that the amount of animal matter produced could be equivalent to that of large herds of animals and flocks of big birds suddenly falling into the sea.

The occurrence of such events, at certain intervals, in hot countries, like the severe winters and damp summers returning after a series of years in the temperate zone, may affect the proportional numbers of almost all classes of animals and plants, and probably prove fatal to the existence of many which would otherwise thrive there; while, on the contrary, the same occurrences can scarcely fail to be favorable to certain species which, if deprived of such aid, might not maintain their ground.

The occurrence of such events, at certain intervals, in hot countries, like severe winters and damp summers returning after several years in the temperate zone, can impact the population levels of almost all types of animals and plants. This may lead to the extinction of many that would otherwise thrive there. Conversely, these same events are likely to benefit certain species that might struggle without such support.

Although it may usually be remarked that the extraordinary increase of some one species is immediately followed and checked by the multiplication of another, yet this does not always happen; partly because many species feed in common on the same kinds of food, and partly because many kinds of food are often consumed indifferently by one and the same species. In the former case, where a variety of different animals have precisely the same taste, as, for example, when many insectivorous birds and reptiles devour alike some particular fly or beetle, the unusual numbers of these insects may cause only a slight and almost imperceptible augmentation of each of these species of bird and reptile. 676 In the other instances, where one animal preys on others of almost every class, as for example, where our English buzzards devour not only small quadrupeds, as rabbits and field-mice, but also birds, frogs, lizards, and insects, the profusion of any one of these last may cause all such general feeders to subsist more exclusively upon the species thus in excess, by which means the balance may be restored.

While it’s often noted that a sudden increase in one species is quickly followed and balanced by the growth of another, this isn't always the case. This happens partly because many species share the same food sources and partly because many types of food can be eaten by the same species. In the first situation, when different animals have the same preference, like when various insect-eating birds and reptiles all go for a specific fly or beetle, a spike in these insects might only lead to a minimal and barely noticeable rise in the populations of those birds and reptiles. 676 In other cases, where one animal hunts a wide range of prey, like how our English buzzards eat not just small mammals like rabbits and field mice, but also birds, frogs, lizards, and insects, a surplus of any one of these can lead these general feeders to rely more on the abundant species. This helps restore balance in the ecosystem.

Agency of omnivorous animals.—The number of species which are nearly omnivorous is considerable; and although every animal has, perhaps, a predilection for some one description of food rather than another, yet some are not even confined to one of the great kingdoms of the organic world. Thus, when the raccoon of the West Indies can procure neither fowls, fish, snails, nor insects, it will attack the sugar-canes, and devour various kinds of grain. The civets, when animal food is scarce, maintain themselves on fruits and roots.

Agency of omnivorous animals.—There are a lot of species that are almost omnivorous; and while every animal might prefer one type of food over another, some aren’t limited to just one of the major kingdoms of living things. For example, when the raccoon in the West Indies can’t find chickens, fish, snails, or insects, it will go after sugarcane and eat different kinds of grains. Similarly, civets, when animal food is hard to come by, survive on fruits and roots.

Numerous birds, which feed indiscriminately on insects and plants, are perhaps more instrumental than any other of the terrestrial tribes in preserving a constant equilibrium between the relative numbers of different classes of animals and vegetables. If the insects become very numerous and devour the plants, these birds will immediately derive a larger portion of their subsistence from insects, just as the Arabians, Syrians, and Hottentots feed on locusts, when the locusts devour their crops.

Many birds, which feed on insects and plants without discrimination, play a crucial role in maintaining a balance between the various types of animals and plants. When insects multiply and start eating the plants, these birds quickly shift to eating more insects for their food, just like the Arabians, Syrians, and Hottentots eat locusts when the locusts destroy their crops.

Reciprocal influence of aquatic and terrestrial species.—The intimate relation of the inhabitants of the water to those of the land, and the influence exerted by each on the relative number of species, must not be overlooked amongst the complicated causes which determine the existence of animals and plants in certain regions. A large portion of the amphibious quadrupeds and reptiles prey partly on aquatic plants and animals, and in part on terrestrial; and a deficiency of one kind of prey causes them to have immediate recourse to the other. The voracity of certain insects, as the dragon-fly, for example, is confined to the water during one stage of their transformations, and in their perfect state to the air. Innumerable water-birds, both of rivers and seas, derive in like manner their food indifferently from either element; so that the abundance or scarcity of prey in one induces them either to forsake or more constantly to haunt the other. Thus an intimate connection between the state of the animate creation in a lake or river, and in the adjoining dry land, is maintained; or between a continent, with its lakes and rivers, and the ocean. It is well known that many birds migrate, during stormy seasons, from the sea-shore into the interior, in search of food; while others, on the contrary, urged by like wants, forsake their inland haunts, and live on substances rejected by the tide.

Reciprocal influence of aquatic and terrestrial species.—The close relationship between the inhabitants of water and those on land, along with the impact each has on the numbers of different species, should not be ignored among the complex factors that influence the presence of animals and plants in specific areas. Many amphibious mammals and reptiles feed on both aquatic and terrestrial plants and animals; a lack of one type of food prompts them to seek the other. The voraciousness of certain insects, like the dragonfly, is limited to water during one stage of their development and shifts to the air when they mature. Countless water birds, whether from rivers or seas, similarly get their food from both environments; thus, the abundance or lack of prey in one leads them to either abandon or frequent the other more often. Therefore, there is a strong connection between the conditions of the living organisms in a lake or river and the surrounding land, or between a continent, with its lakes and rivers, and the ocean. It is well known that many birds migrate from the coast into the interior during stormy seasons in search of food, while others, driven by similar needs, leave their inland habitats to feed on debris left by the tide.

The migration of fish into rivers during the spawning season supplies another link of the same kind. Suppose the salmon to be reduced in numbers by some marine foes, as by seals and grampuses, the consequence must often be, that in the course of a few years the otters at the distance of several hundred miles inland will be lessened in number from the 677 scarcity of fish. On the other hand, if there be a dearth of food for the young fry of the salmon in rivers and estuaries, so that few return to the sea, the sand eels and other marine species, which are usually kept down by the salmon, will swarm in greater profusion.

The migration of fish into rivers during the spawning season provides another similar connection. If salmon populations decline due to marine predators like seals and porpoises, it often leads to a decrease in otter populations several hundred miles inland because of the lack of fish. Conversely, if there is a shortage of food for young salmon in rivers and estuaries, resulting in fewer returning to the sea, sand eels and other marine species that are usually kept in check by the salmon will thrive in larger numbers.

It is unnecessary to accumulate a greater number of illustrations in order to prove that the stations of different plants and animals depend on a great complication of circumstances,—on an immense variety of relations in the state of the inanimate worlds. Every plant requires a certain climate, soil, and other conditions, and often the aid of many animals, in order to maintain its ground. Many animals feed on certain plants, being often restricted to a small number, and sometimes to one only; other members of the animal kingdom feed on plant-eating species, and thus become dependent on the conditions of the stations not only of their prey, but of the plants consumed by them.

It’s not necessary to collect more examples to show that the habitats of different plants and animals depend on a complex set of circumstances—a vast range of relationships within the inanimate world. Each plant needs a specific climate, soil, and other conditions, and often relies on various animals for support to thrive. Many animals eat specific plants, often limited to just a few types, and at times even just one; other animals in the food chain eat these plant-eaters, making them dependent not just on the habitats of their prey but also on the conditions of the plants those prey consume.

Having duly reflected on the nature and extent of these mutual relations in the different parts of the organic and inorganic worlds, we may next proceed to examine the results which may be anticipated from the fluctuations now continually in progress in the state of the earth's surface, and in the geographical distribution of its living productions.

Having thoughtfully considered the nature and extent of these mutual relationships in various parts of the organic and inorganic worlds, we can now move on to examine the outcomes we can expect from the ongoing changes in the state of the earth's surface and the geographical distribution of living things.


CHAPTER XLI.

EXTINCTION OF SPECIES.—CHANGES IN THE STATIONS OF ANIMALS.

Extension of the range of one species alters the condition of many others—The first appearance of a new species causes the chief disturbance—Changes known to have resulted from the advance of human population—Whether man increases the productive powers of the earth—Indigenous quadrupeds and birds extirpated in Great Britain—Extinction of the dodo—Rapid propagation of domestic quadrupeds in America—Power of exterminating species no prerogative of man—Concluding remarks.

Extension of the range of one species changes conditions for many others—The first appearance of a new species leads to major disruptions—Changes are known to have happened due to the growth of the human population—Does humanity boost the earth's productive capacity?—Indigenous land mammals and birds wiped out in Great Britain—Extinction of the dodo—Quick spread of domestic animals in America—The ability to eliminate species is not exclusive to humans—Final thoughts.

We have seen that the stations of animals and plants depend not merely on the influence of external agents in the inanimate world, and the relations of that influence to the structure and habits of each species, but also on the state of the contemporary living beings which inhabit the same part of the globe. In other words, the possibility of the existence of a certain species in a given place, or of its thriving more or less therein, is determined not merely by temperature, humidity, soil, elevation, and other circumstances of the like kind; but also by the existence or non-existence, the abundance or scarcity, of a particular assemblage of other plants and animals in the same region.

We have observed that the habitats of animals and plants depend not just on the impact of external factors in the non-living world and how those factors relate to the structure and behavior of each species, but also on the current state of other living organisms that share the same area of the planet. In other words, whether a certain species can exist in a specific location, or how well it can thrive there, is influenced not only by temperature, humidity, soil, elevation, and similar conditions but also by the presence or absence, and the abundance or scarcity, of specific other plants and animals in that region.

If it be shown that both these classes of circumstances, whether relating to the animate or inanimate creation, are perpetually changing, it will follow that species are subject to incessant vicissitudes; and if 678 the result of these mutations, in the course of ages, be so great as materially to affect the general condition of stations, it will follow that the successive destruction of species must now be part of the regular and constant order of nature.

If it is shown that both these types of circumstances, whether related to living or non-living things, are always changing, it will mean that species are constantly experiencing changes. If 678 the outcome of these changes over the years is significant enough to seriously impact the overall state of stations, it will mean that the ongoing extinction of species must now be a regular and ongoing part of nature's order.

Extension of the range of one species alters the condition of the others.—It will be desirable, first, to consider the effects which every extension of the numbers or geographical range of one species must produce on the condition of others inhabiting the same regions. When the necessary consequences of such extensions have been fully explained, the reader will be prepared to appreciate the important influence which slight modifications in the physical geography of the globe may exert on the condition of organic beings.

When one species expands its range, it affects the conditions of others.—First, we should think about how any increase in the number or geographic range of one species impacts the conditions of other species living in the same areas. Once we fully understand the results of these expansions, the reader will be better equipped to appreciate the significant effect that small changes in the physical geography of the Earth can have on living organisms.

In the first place, it is clear that when any region is stocked with as great a variety of animals and plants as the productive powers of that region will enable it to support, the addition of any new species, or the permanent numerical increase of one previously established, must always be attended either by the local extermination or the numerical decrease of some other species.

In the first place, it's clear that when any area has as wide a variety of animals and plants as its resources can support, the introduction of any new species, or the long-term increase in the numbers of an already established one, will always result in either the local extinction or the decline in numbers of some other species.

There may undoubtedly be considerable fluctuations from year to year, and the equilibrium may be again restored without any permanent alteration; for, in particular seasons, a greater supply of heat, humidity, or other causes, may augment the total quantity of vegetable produce, in which case all the animals subsisting on vegetable food, and others which prey on them, may multiply without any one species giving way: but whilst the aggregate quantity of vegetable produce remains unaltered, the progressive increase of one animal or plant implies the decline of another.

There will definitely be significant changes from year to year, and balance can be restored without any lasting changes; during certain seasons, an increase in heat, humidity, or other factors can boost the overall amount of plant life. In this situation, all the animals that eat plants, along with those that feed on them, may increase in number without any single species declining. However, while the total amount of plant life stays the same, the ongoing growth of one animal or plant means that another must decrease.

All agriculturists and gardeners are familiar with the fact that when weeds intrude themselves into the space appropriated to cultivated species, the latter are starved in their growth, or stifled. If we abandon for a short time a field or garden, a host of indigenous plants,

All farmers and gardeners know that when weeds invade the area meant for cultivated plants, the latter struggle to grow or get suffocated. If we leave a field or garden unattended for a little while, a large number of native plants,

The darnel, hemlock, and rank fumitory,

The darnel, hemlock, and foul fumitory,

pour in and obtain the mastery, extirpating the exotics, or putting an end to the monopoly of some native plants.

pour in and gain control, removing the outsiders or ending the dominance of certain native plants.

If we inclose a park, and stock it with as many deer as the herbage will support, we cannot add sheep without lessening the number of the deer; nor can other herbivorous species be subsequently introduced, unless the individuals of each species in the park become fewer in proportion.

If we enclose a park and fill it with as many deer as the grass can support, we can’t add sheep without decreasing the number of deer; nor can we introduce other herbivorous animals later, unless the number of each species in the park is reduced proportionately.

So, if there be an island where leopards are the only beasts of prey, and the lion, tiger, and hyæna afterwards enter, the leopards, if they stand their ground, will be reduced in number. If the locusts then arrive and swarm greatly, they may deprive a large number of plant-eating animals of their food, and thereby cause a famine, not only among them, but among the beasts of prey: certain species perhaps, which had the weakest footing in the island, may thus be annihilated.

So, if there’s an island where leopards are the only predators, and then lions, tigers, and hyenas come in, the leopards, if they stay and fight, will end up fewer in number. If locusts then swarm in large numbers, they could take away a lot of the food from herbivores, leading to a famine not just for them, but also for the predators. Certain species that were already struggling on the island might then be wiped out.

679 We have seen how many distinct geographical provinces there are of aquatic and terrestrial species, and how great are the powers of migration conferred on different classes, whereby the inhabitants of one region may be enabled from time to time to invade another, and do actually so migrate and diffuse themselves over new countries. Now, although our knowledge of the history of the animate creation dates from so recent a period, that we can scarcely trace the advance or decline of any animal or plant, except in those cases where the influence of man has intervened; yet we can easily conceive what must happen when some new colony of wild animals or plants enters a region for the first time, and succeeds in establishing itself.

679 We’ve seen how many different geographical areas exist for aquatic and land species, and how different groups have impressive migration abilities, allowing the inhabitants of one region to sometimes invade another and actually spread into new areas. Although our understanding of the history of living beings is quite recent, making it hard to track the rise or fall of any animal or plant—except in instances where humans have changed things—we can easily imagine what happens when a new group of wild animals or plants arrives in a region for the first time and manages to settle in.

Supposed effects of the first entrance of the polar bear into Iceland.—Let us consider how great are the devastations committed at certain periods by the Greenland bears, when they are drifted to the shores of Iceland in considerable numbers on the ice. These periodical invasions are formidable even to man; so that when the bears arrive, the inhabitants collect together, and go in pursuit of them with fire-arms—each native who slays one being rewarded by the King of Denmark. The Danes of old, when they landed in their marauding expeditions upon our coast, hardly excited more alarm, nor did our islanders muster more promptly for the defence of their lives and property against the common enemy, than the modern Icelanders against these formidable brutes. It often happens, says Henderson, that the natives are pursued by the bear when he has been long at sea, and when his natural ferocity has been heightened by the keenness of hunger; if unarmed, it is frequently by stratagem only that they make their escape.965

Supposed effects of the first entrance of the polar bear into Iceland.—Let’s look at the significant destruction caused at certain times by the Greenland bears when they drift to the shores of Iceland in large numbers on the ice. These periodic invasions are a serious threat even to people; when the bears show up, the locals gather together and hunt them down with firearms—each local who kills one is rewarded by the King of Denmark. In the past, when the Danes landed on our coast for their plundering raids, they didn’t cause more alarm, nor did our islanders respond more quickly to defend their lives and property against a common enemy than the modern Icelanders do against these powerful beasts. It often happens, as Henderson notes, that the locals are chased by a bear after he has been at sea for a long time, and his natural aggression has been intensified by hunger; if they are unarmed, they frequently escape only by using clever tactics.965

Let us cast our thoughts back to the period when the first polar bears reached Iceland, before it was colonized by the Norwegians in 874: we may imagine the breaking up of an immense barrier of ice like that which, in 1816 and the following year, disappeared from the east coast of Greenland, which it had surrounded for four centuries. By the aid of such means of transportation a great number of these quadrupeds might effect a landing at the same time, and the havoc which they would make among the species previously settled in the island would be terrific. The deer, foxes, seals, and even birds, on which these animals sometimes prey, would be soon thinned down.

Let’s think back to the time when the first polar bears arrived in Iceland, before the Norwegians colonized it in 874: we can picture a massive ice barrier breaking apart, similar to what happened in 1816 and the following year when it vanished from the east coast of Greenland, where it had been for four centuries. With the help of this mode of transport, a large number of these animals could land at the same time, and the destruction they would cause among the species already living on the island would be immense. The deer, foxes, seals, and even birds, which these animals sometimes prey on, would soon face a severe decline.

But this would be a part only, and probably an insignificant portion, of the aggregate amount of change brought about by the new invader. The plants on which the deer fed, being less consumed in consequence of the lessened numbers of that herbivorous species, would soon supply more food to several insects, and probably to some terrestrial testacea, so that the latter would gain ground. The increase of these would furnish other insects and birds with food, so that the numbers of these last would be augmented. The diminution of the seals would afford a respite to some fish which they had persecuted; and these fish, in their turn, would then 680 multiply and press upon their peculiar prey. Many water-fowls, the eggs and young of which are devoured by foxes, would increase when the foxes were thinned down by the bears; and the fish on which the water-fowls subsisted would then, in their turn, be less numerous. Thus the numerical proportions of a great number of the inhabitants, both of the land and sea, might be permanently altered by the settling of one new species in the region; and the changes caused indirectly would ramify through all classes of the living creation, and be almost endless.

But this would only be a small part, and probably an insignificant portion, of the total change caused by the new invader. The plants that the deer fed on, now less consumed because of the reduced numbers of that herbivorous species, would soon provide more food for several insects and likely for some land snails, meaning the latter would thrive. The increase in these insects would provide food for more insects and birds, so their populations would grow. The decrease in seals would give some fish a break from being hunted, and these fish would, in turn, multiply and then compete with their specific prey. Many waterfowl, whose eggs and young are eaten by foxes, would increase when the foxes were reduced by the bears; and the fish that the waterfowl relied on would subsequently become less numerous. Thus, the population proportions of many inhabitants both on land and in the sea might be permanently changed by the arrival of one new species in the area; and the changes caused indirectly would spread throughout all levels of living things and could be almost endless.

An actual illustration of what we have here only proposed hypothetically, is in some degree afforded by the selection of small islands by the eider duck for its residence during the season of incubation, its nest being seldom if ever found on the shores of the main land, or even of a large island. The Icelanders are so well aware of this, that they have expended a great deal of labor in forming artificial islands, by separating from the main land certain promontories, joined to it by narrow isthmuses. This insular position is necessary to guard against the destruction of the eggs and young birds, by foxes, dogs, and other animals. One year, says Hooker, it happened that, in the small island of Vidoe, adjoining the coast of Iceland, a fox got over upon the ice, and caused great alarm, as an immense number of ducks were then sitting on their eggs or young ones. It was long before he was taken, which was at last, however, effected by bringing another fox to the island, and fastening it by a string near the haunt of the former, by which he was allured within shot of the hunter.966

An actual example of what we’re discussing, which was only proposed hypothetically, can be partially seen in the way eider ducks choose small islands for nesting during the incubation season. Their nests are rarely found on the shores of the mainland or even on large islands. The Icelanders are well aware of this, so they have put significant effort into creating artificial islands by separating certain promontories from the mainland, connecting them with narrow isthmuses. This island setup is crucial to protect the eggs and young birds from foxes, dogs, and other animals. One year, as Hooker recounts, a fox managed to cross onto the small island of Vidoe, off the coast of Iceland, which created a lot of panic because many ducks were nesting or had young chicks at that time. It took a while to capture the fox, but eventually, it was done by bringing another fox to the island and tying it near the other fox's territory, which lured him within range of the hunter.966

The first appearance of a new species causes the chief disturbance.—It is usually the first appearance of an animal or plant, in a region to which it was previously a stranger, that gives rise to the chief alteration; since, after a time, an equilibrium is again established. But it must require ages before such a new adjustment of the relative forces of so many conflicting agents can be definitely settled. The causes in simultaneous action are so numerous, that they admit of an almost infinite number of combinations; and it is necessary that all these should have occurred once before the total amount of change, capable of flowing from any new disturbing force, can be estimated.

The first appearance of a new species causes the main disturbance.—It's usually the initial arrival of an animal or plant in a region where it was previously unknown that leads to the biggest change; eventually, a new balance is reestablished. However, it can take ages for a new adjustment of the relative influences of so many conflicting factors to be firmly established. The causes happening at the same time are so numerous that they allow for nearly infinite combinations, and it’s essential that all these combinations have occurred at least once before we can truly gauge the total amount of change that could result from any new disruptive force.

Thus, for example, suppose that once in two centuries a frost of unusual intensity, or a volcanic eruption of great violence accompanied by floods from the melting of glaciers, should occur in Iceland; or an epidemic disease, fatal to the larger number of individuals of some one species, and not affecting others,—these, and a variety of other contingencies, all of which may occur at once, or at periods separated by different intervals of time, ought to happen before it would be possible for us to declare what ultimate alteration the presence of any new comer, such as the bear before mentioned, might occasion in the animal population of the isle.

So, for example, let’s say that once every two centuries, there’s a severe frost or a major volcanic eruption in Iceland, along with floods caused by melting glaciers; or an epidemic that is deadly to most individuals of a specific species but doesn't affect others—these, along with a range of other possibilities, which could happen simultaneously or at different times, would all need to occur before we could determine what lasting changes the arrival of any newcomer, like the bear mentioned earlier, might cause in the island's animal population.

Every new condition in the state of the organic or inorganic creation, a new animal or plant, an additional snow-clad mountain, any permanent change, however slight in comparison to the whole, gives rise to a 681 new order of things, and may make a material change in regard to some one or more species. Yet a swarm of locusts, or a frost of extreme intensity, or an epidemic disease, may pass away without any great apparent derangement; no species may be lost, and all may soon recover their former relative numbers, because the same scourges may have visited the region again and again, at preceding periods. Every plant that was incapable of resisting such a degree of cold, every animal which was exposed to be entirely cut off by an epidemic or by famine caused by the consumption of vegetation by the locusts, may have perished already, so that the subsequent recurrence of similar catastrophes is attended only by a temporary change.

Every new condition in the state of organic or inorganic creation, a new animal or plant, an additional snow-covered mountain, any permanent change, no matter how small compared to the whole, creates a 681 new order of things and can lead to a significant change in one or more species. However, a swarm of locusts, an extreme frost, or an epidemic disease can happen without causing major disruption; no species may go extinct, and most may quickly return to their previous populations, because similar disasters might have affected the area repeatedly in the past. Every plant that couldn't withstand such cold, every animal that was vulnerable to being wiped out by a disease or starvation from locusts consuming the vegetation, may have already died out, so the next occurrence of similar disasters only brings about a temporary change.

Changes caused by Man

We are best acquainted with the mutations brought about by the progress of human population, and the growth of plants and animals favored by man. To these, therefore, we should in the first instance turn our attention. If we conclude, from the concurrent testimony of history and of the evidence yielded by geological data, that man is, comparatively speaking, of very modern origin, we must at once perceive how great a revolution in the state of the animate world the increase of the human race, considered merely as consumers of a certain quantity of organic matter, must necessarily cause.

We are most familiar with the changes brought about by the growth of the human population and the development of plants and animals that benefit from human intervention. So, we should first focus on these. If we gather from both historical accounts and geological evidence that humans are relatively new on the scene, we need to recognize how significant a shift in the state of living beings the rise of the human population, seen simply as consumers of a certain amount of organic matter, must inevitably cause.

Whether man increases the productive powers of the earth.—It may perhaps, be said, that man has, in some degree, compensated for the appropriation to himself of so much food, by artificially improving the natural productiveness of soils, by irrigation, manure, and a judicious intermixture of mineral ingredients conveyed from different localities. But it admits of reasonable doubt whether, upon the whole, we fertilize or impoverish the lands which we occupy. This assertion may seem startling to many; because they are so much in the habit of regarding the sterility or productiveness of land in relation to the wants of man, and not as regards the organic world generally. It is difficult, at first, to conceive, if a morass is converted into arable land, and made to yield a crop of grain, even of moderate abundance, that we have not improved the capabilities of the habitable surface—that we have not empowered it to support a larger quantity of organic life. In such cases, however, a tract, before of no utility to man, may be reclaimed, and become of high agricultural importance, though it may, nevertheless, yield a scantier vegetation. If a lake be drained, and turned into a meadow, the space will provide sustenance to man, and many terrestrial animals serviceable to him, but not, perhaps, so much food as it previously yielded to the aquatic races.

Whether humans increase the productive powers of the earth.—It could be argued that people have, to some extent, made up for taking so much food for themselves by artificially enhancing the natural fertility of the soil through irrigation, fertilizers, and a careful mix of minerals sourced from various places. However, it's reasonable to question whether we are overall enriching or depleting the lands we occupy. This statement might surprise many because they are used to thinking about the fertility or barrenness of land in relation to human needs, rather than considering the entire organic world. At first, it’s hard to believe that if a marsh is turned into farmland and yields even a modest grain crop, we haven't improved the land's ability to support more organic life. In such cases, though, an area that was previously of no use to humans can be reclaimed and become agriculturally valuable, even if it may produce less plant life overall. If a lake is drained and transformed into a meadow, the land will provide food for humans and many land animals that are useful to them, but perhaps not as much food as it previously supplied to aquatic creatures.

If the pestiferous Pontine marshes were drained, and covered with corn, like the plains of the Po, they might, perhaps, feed a smaller number of animals than they do now; for these morasses are filled with herds of buffaloes and swine, and they swarm with birds, reptiles, and insects.

If the troublesome Pontine marshes were drained and planted with corn like the plains of the Po, they might, possibly, support fewer animals than they do now; because these swamps are filled with herds of buffalo and pigs, and they are teeming with birds, reptiles, and insects.

682 The felling of dense and lofty forests, which covered, even within the records of history, a considerable space on the globe, now tenanted by civilized man, must generally have lessened the amount of vegetable food throughout the space where these woods grew. We must also take into our account the area covered by towns, and a still larger surface occupied by roads.

682 The cutting down of thick and tall forests, which even in historical records covered a significant area of the world now inhabited by civilized people, has likely reduced the amount of plant-based food in the regions where these woods once thrived. We also need to consider the land taken up by cities, and an even larger area used for roads.

If we force the soil to bear extraordinary crops one year, we are, perhaps, compelled to let it lie fallow the next. But nothing so much counterbalances the fertilizing effects of human art as the extensive cultivation of foreign herbs and shrubs, which, although they are often more nutritious to man, seldom thrive with the same rank luxuriance as the native plants of a district. Man is, in truth, continually striving to diminish the natural diversity of the stations of animals and plants in every country, and to reduce them all to a small number fitted for species of economical use. He may succeed perfectly in attaining his object, even though the vegetation be comparatively meagre, and the total amount of animal life be greatly lessened.

If we push the soil to produce extraordinary crops in one year, we might have to let it rest the following year. However, nothing counteracts the enriching effects of human efforts as much as the widespread farming of foreign plants and shrubs, which, although often more nutritious for people, rarely thrive with the same vigor as the native plants in an area. In reality, humans are constantly working to reduce the natural diversity of animal and plant habitats in every country, aiming to narrow them down to a few that are useful for economic purposes. He might achieve this goal perfectly, even if the vegetation is relatively sparse and the overall amount of animal life is significantly decreased.

Spix and Martius have given a lively description of the incredible number of insects which lay waste the crops in Brazil, besides swarms of monkeys, flocks of parrots, and other birds, as well as the paca, agouti, and wild swine. They describe the torment which the planter and the naturalist suffer from the musquitoes, and the devastation of the ants and blattæ; they speak of the dangers to which they were exposed from the jaguar, the poisonous serpents, crocodiles, scorpions, centipedes, and spiders. But with the increasing population and cultivation of the country, say these naturalists, these evils will gradually diminish; when the inhabitants have cut down the woods, drained the marshes, made roads in all directions, and founded villages and towns, man will, by degrees, triumph over the rank vegetation and the noxious animals, and all the elements will second and amply recompense his activity.967

Spix and Martius provide a vibrant account of the vast number of insects that devastate crops in Brazil, along with swarms of monkeys, flocks of parrots, and other birds, as well as the paca, agouti, and wild hogs. They describe the suffering experienced by farmers and naturalists from the mosquitoes, and the destruction caused by ants and cockroaches; they mention the threats posed by jaguars, venomous snakes, crocodiles, scorpions, centipedes, and spiders. However, these naturalists believe that as the population and agricultural activities increase in the country, these problems will gradually lessen. Once people cut down the forests, drain the swamps, build roads in all directions, and establish villages and towns, humanity will slowly conquer the dense vegetation and harmful animals, and all the elements will support and richly reward their efforts.967

The number of human beings now peopling the earth is supposed to amount to eight hundred millions, so that we may easily understand how great a number of beasts of prey, birds, and animals of every class, this prodigious population must have displaced, independently of the still more important consequences which have followed from the derangement brought about by man in the relative numerical strength of particular species.

The number of people currently living on Earth is estimated to be around eight hundred million, so we can easily understand how many predators, birds, and animals of every kind this massive population must have pushed out, not to mention the even more significant effects that have resulted from the disruption caused by humans in the relative numbers of certain species.

Indigenous quadrupeds and birds extirpated in Great Britain.—Let us make some inquiries into the extent of the influence which the progress of society has exerted during the last seven or eight centuries, in altering the distribution of indigenous British animals. Dr. Fleming has prosecuted this inquiry with his usual zeal and ability; and in a memoir on the subject has enumerated the best-authenticated examples of the decrease or extirpation of certain species during a period when 683 our population has made the most rapid advances. I shall offer a brief outline of his results.968

Indigenous quadrupeds and birds wiped out in Great Britain.—Let’s look into how much the progress of society has changed the distribution of native British animals over the last seven or eight centuries. Dr. Fleming has pursued this inquiry with his usual enthusiasm and skill, and in a paper on the topic, he has listed the most well-documented cases of the decrease or extinction of certain species during a time when 683 our population has rapidly grown. I will present a brief summary of his findings.968

The stag, as well as the fallow deer and the roe, were formerly so abundant in our island, that, according to Lesley, from five hundred to a thousand were sometimes slain at a hunting match; but the native races would already have been extinguished, had they not been carefully preserved in certain forests. The otter, the marten, and the polecat, were also in sufficient numbers to be pursued for the sake of their fur; but they have now been reduced within very narrow bounds. The wild cat and fox have also been sacrificed throughout the greater part of the country, for the security of the poultry-yard or the fold. Badgers have been expelled from nearly every district, which at former periods they inhabited.

The stag, along with the fallow deer and roe deer, used to be so plentiful on our island that, according to Lesley, five hundred to a thousand would sometimes be killed in a hunting event. However, the native species would have already become extinct if they hadn't been carefully protected in certain forests. Otters, martens, and polecats were also common enough to be hunted for their fur, but their numbers have now been greatly reduced. Wildcats and foxes have been eliminated across most of the country to protect poultry and livestock. Badgers have been driven out of almost every area where they once lived.

Besides these, which have been driven out from their favorite haunts, and everywhere reduced in number, there are some which have been wholly extirpated; such as the ancient breed of indigenous horses, and the wild boar; of the wild oxen a few remains are still preserved in some of the old English parks. The beaver, which is eagerly sought after for its fur, had become scarce at the close of the ninth century; and, by the twelfth century, was only to be met with, according to Giraldus de Barri, in one river in Wales, and another in Scotland. The wolf, once so much dreaded by our ancestors, is said to have maintained its ground in Ireland so late as the beginning of the eighteenth century (1710), though it had been extirpated in Scotland thirty years before, and in England at a much earlier period. The bear, which, in Wales, was regarded as a beast of the chase equal to the hare or the boar969, only perished, as a native of Scotland, in the year 1057.970

Besides these, which have been driven out from their favorite areas and everywhere reduced in number, there are some that have been completely wiped out; like the ancient breed of native horses and the wild boar. A few wild oxen still exist in some of the old English parks. The beaver, which is highly sought after for its fur, had become rare by the end of the ninth century; and by the twelfth century, according to Giraldus de Barri, it could only be found in one river in Wales and another in Scotland. The wolf, once feared by our ancestors, is said to have survived in Ireland as late as the beginning of the eighteenth century (1710), though it had been eradicated in Scotland thirty years earlier and in England much earlier. The bear, which was regarded in Wales as a game animal comparable to the hare or the boar969, was only eliminated as a native species in Scotland in the year 1057.970

Many native birds of prey have also been the subjects of unremitting persecution. The eagles, larger hawks, and ravens, have disappeared from the more cultivated districts. The haunts of the mallard, the snipe, the redshank, and the bittern, have been drained equally with the summer dwellings of the lapwing and the curlew. But these species still linger in some portion of the British isles; whereas the larger capercailzies or wood grouse, formerly natives of the pine-forests of Ireland and Scotland, have been destroyed within the last sixty years. The egret and the crane, which appear to have been formerly very common in Scotland, are now only occasional visitants.971

Many native birds of prey have faced constant persecution. Eagles, larger hawks, and ravens have vanished from more developed areas. The habitats of the mallard, snipe, redshank, and bittern have been drained just like the summer homes of the lapwing and curlew. However, these species still exist in some parts of the British Isles; on the other hand, the larger capercailzies or wood grouse, which used to inhabit the pine forests of Ireland and Scotland, have been wiped out in the last sixty years. The egret and the crane, which seemed to have been quite common in Scotland before, now only visit occasionally.971

The bustard (Otis tarda), observes Graves, in his British Ornithology972, "was formerly seen in the downs and heaths of various parts of our island, in flocks of forty or fifty birds; whereas it is now a circumstance of rare occurrence to meet with a single individual." Bewick also remarks, "that they were formerly more common in this island than at present; they are now found only in the open counties of the 684 south and east—in the plains of Wiltshire, Dorsetshire, and some parts of Yorkshire."973 In the few years that have elapsed since Bewick wrote, this bird has entirely disappeared from Wiltshire and Dorsetshire.

The bustard (Otis tarda), notes Graves in his British Ornithology972, "used to be seen in the downs and heaths across different parts of our island, in flocks of forty or fifty birds; now, it’s very rare to even see a single one." Bewick adds, "they used to be more common in this island than they are today; now they are found only in the open counties of the 684 south and east—in the plains of Wiltshire, Dorsetshire, and some areas of Yorkshire."973 In the few years since Bewick wrote this, the bird has completely vanished from Wiltshire and Dorsetshire.

These changes, it may be observed, are derived from very imperfect memorials, and relate only to the larger and more conspicuous animals inhabiting a small spot on the globe; but they cannot fail to exalt our conception of the enormous revolutions which, in the course of several thousand years, the whole human species must have effected.

These changes, as you can see, come from incomplete records and only refer to the bigger, more noticeable animals living in a small area of the world; however, they certainly elevate our understanding of the massive transformations that the entire human race must have achieved over thousands of years.

Extinction of the dodo.—The kangaroo and the emu are retreating rapidly before the progress of colonization in Australia; and it scarcely admits of doubt, that the general cultivation of that country must lead to the extirpation of both. The most striking example of the loss, even within the last two centuries, of a remarkable species, is that of the dodo—a bird first seen by the Dutch, when they landed on the Isle of France, at that time uninhabited, immediately after the discovery of the passage to the East Indies by the Cape of Good Hope. It was of a large size, and singular form; its wings short, like those of an ostrich, and wholly incapable of sustaining its heavy body, even for a short flight. In its general appearance it differed from the ostrich, cassowary, or any known bird.974

Extinction of the dodo.—The kangaroo and the emu are quickly disappearing due to the spread of colonization in Australia; it's pretty clear that the widespread farming in that region will result in the extinction of both species. A striking example of a species lost, even within the last two centuries, is the dodo—a bird first encountered by the Dutch when they arrived on the Isle of France, which was uninhabited at the time, shortly after the discovery of the route to the East Indies around the Cape of Good Hope. It was large and had a unique shape; its wings were short, like those of an ostrich, and completely unable to support its heavy body, even for a brief flight. In its overall appearance, it was different from the ostrich, cassowary, or any known bird.974

Many naturalists gave figures of the dodo after the commencement of the seventeenth century; and there is a painting of it in the British Museum, which is said to have been taken from a living individual. Beneath the painting is a leg, in a fine state of preservation, which ornithologists are agreed cannot belong to any other known bird. In the museum at Oxford, also, there is a foot and a head in an imperfect state.

Many naturalists provided illustrations of the dodo after the start of the seventeenth century, and there’s a painting of it in the British Museum, said to be based on a living specimen. Below the painting is a leg, well-preserved, which ornithologists agree cannot belong to any other known bird. In the museum at Oxford, there’s also a foot and a head in poor condition.

In spite of the most active search, during the last century, no information respecting the dodo was obtained, and some authors have gone so far as to pretend that it never existed; but a great mass of satisfactory evidence in favor of its recent existence has now been collected by Mr. Broderip,975 and by Mr. Strickland and Dr. Melville. Mr. Strickland, agreeing with Professor Reinhardt, of Copenhagen, in referring the dodo to the Columbidæ, calls it a "vulture-like frugivorous pigeon." It appears, also, that another short-winged bird of the same order, called "The Solitaire," inhabited the small island of Rodrigues, 300 miles east of the Mauritius, and has been exterminated by man, as have one or two different but allied birds of the Isle of Bourbon.976

Despite extensive searching over the past century, no information about the dodo has been found, and some writers have even claimed it never existed. However, a significant amount of solid evidence supporting its recent existence has been gathered by Mr. Broderip,975 Mr. Strickland, and Dr. Melville. Mr. Strickland, aligning with Professor Reinhardt from Copenhagen, categorizes the dodo as part of the Columbidæ family and describes it as a "vulture-like fruit-eating pigeon." It also appears that another short-winged bird from the same order, called "The Solitaire," lived on the small island of Rodrigues, located 300 miles east of Mauritius, and has been wiped out by humans, along with one or two other similar birds from the Isle of Bourbon.976

685 Rapid propagation of domestic quadrupeds over the American continent.—Next to the direct agency of man, his indirect influence in multiplying the numbers of large herbivorous quadrupeds of domesticated races may be regarded as one of the most obvious causes of the extermination of species. On this, and on several other grounds, the introduction of the horse, ox, and other mammalia, into America, and their rapid propagation over that continent within the last three centuries, is a fact of great importance in natural history. The extraordinary herds of wild cattle and horses which overran the plains of South America sprung from a very few pairs first carried over by the Spaniards; and they prove that the wide geographical range of large species in great continents does not necessarily imply that they have existed there from remote periods.

685 Rapid spread of domestic four-legged animals across the American continent.—Alongside the direct actions of humans, their indirect impact on increasing the populations of large domesticated herbivores can be considered one of the main reasons for the extinction of certain species. For this reason, as well as others, the introduction of horses, cattle, and other mammals to America, along with their quick spread across the continent in the last three hundred years, is a significant event in natural history. The vast herds of wild cattle and horses that roamed the plains of South America originated from just a few pairs initially brought over by the Spaniards; these herds demonstrate that the widespread presence of large species on large continents doesn’t necessarily mean they have been there for a long time.

Humboldt observes, in his Travels, on the authority of Azzara, that it is believed there exist, in the Pampas of Buenos Ayres, twelve million cows and three million horses, without comprising, in this enumeration, the cattle that have no acknowledged proprietor. In the Llanos of Caraccas, the rich hateros, or proprietors of pastoral farms, are entirely ignorant of the number of cattle they possess. The young are branded with a mark peculiar to each herd, and some of the most wealthy owners mark as many as fourteen thousand a year.977 In the northern plains, from the Orinoco to the lake of Maraycabo, M. Depons reckoned that 1,200,000 oxen, 180,000 horses, and 90,000 mules, wandered at large.978 In some parts of the valley of the Mississippi, especially in the country of the Osage Indians, wild horses are immensely numerous.

Humboldt notes in his Travels, citing Azzara, that it is believed there are about twelve million cows and three million horses in the Pampas of Buenos Ayres, not including the cattle that don’t have an owner. In the Llanos of Caraccas, the wealthy haters, or owners of ranches, have no idea how many cattle they own. The young animals are branded with a unique mark for each herd, and some of the richest owners brand as many as fourteen thousand each year.977 In the northern plains, from the Orinoco to Lake Maracaibo, M. Depons estimated that 1,200,000 oxen, 180,000 horses, and 90,000 mules roamed freely.978 In certain areas of the Mississippi Valley, particularly in the territory of the Osage Indians, wild horses are incredibly abundant.

The establishment of black cattle in America dates from Columbus's second voyage to St. Domingo. They there multiplied rapidly; and that island presently became a kind of nursery from which these animals were successively transported to various parts of the continental coast, and from thence into the interior. Notwithstanding these numerous exportations, in twenty-seven years after the discovery of the island, herds of four thousand head, as we learn from Oviedo, were not uncommon, and there were even some that amounted to eight thousand. In 1587, the number of hides exported from St. Domingo alone, according to Acosta's report, was 35,444; and in the same year there were exported 64,350 from the ports of New Spain. This was in the sixty-fifth year after the taking of Mexico, previous to which event the Spaniards, who came into that country, had not been able to engage in anything else than war.979 Every one is aware that these animals are now established throughout the American continent from Canada to the Straits of Magellan.

The introduction of black cattle in America started with Columbus's second trip to St. Domingo. They quickly multiplied there, and the island soon became a sort of nursery, supplying these animals to different parts of the continental coast and later into the interior. Despite these many exports, twenty-seven years after the discovery of the island, herds of four thousand were common, as noted by Oviedo, with some even reaching eight thousand. In 1587, according to Acosta's report, 35,444 hides were exported from St. Domingo alone, and that same year, 64,350 were exported from the ports of New Spain. This was during the sixty-fifth year after the conquest of Mexico, when the Spaniards arriving in that region had only been able to focus on warfare.979 Everyone knows that these animals are now found all over the American continent, from Canada to the Straits of Magellan.

The ass has thriven very generally in the New World; and we learn from Ulloa, that in Quito they ran wild, and multiplied in amazing numbers, so as to become a nuisance. They grazed together in herds, 686 and when attacked defended themselves with their mouths. If a horse happened to stray into the places where they fed, they all fell upon him, and did not cease biting and kicking till they left him dead.980

The donkey has thrived quite well in the New World; we learn from Ulloa that in Quito they went wild and multiplied in astonishing numbers, becoming a real problem. They grazed together in herds, 686 and when threatened, they defended themselves with their mouths. If a horse happened to wander into the areas where they were grazing, they would all attack it and wouldn't stop biting and kicking until it was dead.980

The first hogs were carried to America by Columbus, and established in the Island of St. Domingo the year following its discovery, in November, 1493. In succeeding years they were introduced into other places where the Spaniards settled; and, in the space of half a century, they were found established in the New World, from the latitude of 25° north, to the 40th degree of south latitude. Sheep, also, and goats have multiplied enormously in the New World, as have also the cat and the rat; which last, as before stated, has been imported unintentionally in ships. The dogs introduced by man which have at different periods become wild in America, hunted in packs, like the wolf and the jackall, destroying not only hogs, but the calves and foals of the wild cattle and horses.

The first pigs were brought to America by Columbus and introduced to the Island of St. Domingo the year after its discovery, in November 1493. In the following years, they were taken to other areas where the Spaniards settled, and within fifty years, they were established in the New World, ranging from 25° north latitude to 40° south latitude. Sheep and goats also multiplied rapidly in the New World, along with cats and rats; the latter, as mentioned earlier, was accidentally imported on ships. The dogs that were brought by humans eventually went wild in America, hunting in packs like wolves and jackals, preying not only on pigs but also on the calves and foals of wild cattle and horses.

Ulloa in his voyage, and Buffon on the authority of old writers, relate a fact which illustrates very clearly the principle before explained, of the check which the increase of one animal necessarily offers to that of another. The Spaniards had introduced goats into the Island of Juan Fernandez, where they became so prolific as to furnish the pirates who infested those seas with provisions. In order to cut off this resource from the buccaneers, a number of dogs were turned loose into the island; and so numerous did they become in their turn, that they destroyed the goats in every accessible part, after which the number of the wild dogs again decreased.981

Ulloa during his voyage, and Buffon based on old writers, describe a fact that clearly illustrates the principle we discussed earlier about how the growth of one animal limits the growth of another. The Spaniards brought goats to the Island of Juan Fernandez, where they multiplied so quickly that they provided food for the pirates operating in those waters. To cut off this food source for the buccaneers, a bunch of dogs were released onto the island; they multiplied so much that they wiped out the goats in every accessible area, after which the wild dog population started to decline again.981

Increase of rein-deer imported into Iceland.—As an example of the rapidity with which a large tract may become peopled by the offspring of a single pair of quadrupeds, it may be mentioned that in the year 1773 thirteen rein-deer were exported from Norway, only three of which reached Iceland. These were turned loose into the mountains of Guldbringè Syssel, where they multiplied so greatly, in the course of forty years, that it was not uncommon to meet with herds, consisting of from forty to one hundred, in various districts.

Increase of reindeer imported into Iceland.—As an example of how quickly a large area can be populated by the offspring of just a single pair of mammals, it’s worth noting that in 1773, thirteen reindeer were shipped from Norway, but only three made it to Iceland. These were released into the mountains of Guldbringè Syssel, where they multiplied so much over the next forty years that it became common to encounter herds ranging from forty to one hundred in various areas.

The rein-deer, observes a modern writer, is in Lapland a loser by his connexion with man, but Iceland will be this creature's paradise. There is, in the interior, a tract which Sir. G. Mackenzie computes at not less than forty thousand square miles, without a single human habitation, and almost entirely unknown to the natives themselves. There are no wolves: the Icelanders will keep out the bears; and the reindeer, being almost unmolested by man, will have no enemy whatever, unless it has brought with it its own tormenting gad-fly.982

The reindeer, as a modern writer points out, suffers in Lapland due to its connection with humans, but Iceland would be like paradise for this creature. In the interior, there's an area that Sir G. Mackenzie estimates is at least forty thousand square miles, without a single human settlement, and almost completely unknown to the locals. There are no wolves; the Icelanders will keep out the bears; and with almost no human interference, the reindeer will have no enemies at all, unless it has brought its own annoying gad-fly with it.982

Besides the quadrupeds before enumerated, our domestic fowls have also succeeded in the West Indies and America, where they have the 687 common fowl, the goose, the duck, the peacock, the pigeon, and the guinea-fowl. As these were often taken suddenly from the temperate to very hot regions, they were not reared at first without much difficulty: but after a few generations, they became familiarized to the climate, which, in many cases, approached much nearer than that of Europe to the temperature of their original native countries.

Besides the previously mentioned animals, our farm birds have also thrived in the West Indies and America, where we have the 687 common chicken, goose, duck, peacock, pigeon, and guinea fowl. Since these birds were often relocated suddenly from temperate to very hot areas, they weren't raised without significant challenges at first. However, after a few generations, they adapted to the climate, which in many instances was much closer to the temperatures of their original homelands than that of Europe.

The fact of so many millions of wild and tame individuals of our domestic species, almost all of them the largest quadrupeds and birds, having been propagated throughout the new continent within the short period that has elapsed since the discovery of America, while no appreciable improvement can have been made in the productive powers of that vast continent, affords abundant evidence of the extraordinary changes which accompany the diffusion and progressive advancement of the human race over the globe. That it should have remained for us to witness such mighty revolutions is a proof, even if there was no other evidence, that the entrance of man into the planet is, comparatively speaking, of extremely modern date, and that the effects of his agency are only beginning to be felt.

The existence of so many millions of wild and domesticated members of our domestic species, almost all of them the largest mammals and birds, having spread across the new continent in the short time since America was discovered, while no significant improvements have been made in the land's productive capabilities, clearly shows the remarkable changes that come with the expansion and progress of humanity around the world. That we are here to witness such major transformations proves, even without any other evidence, that humans' arrival on this planet is, relatively speaking, a very recent event, and that the impact of our actions is just beginning to be realized.

Population which the globe is capable of supporting.—A modern writer has estimated, that there are in America upwards of four million square miles of useful soil, each capable of supporting 200 persons; and nearly six million, each mile capable of supporting 490 persons.983 If this conjecture be true, it will follow, as that author observes, that if the natural resources of America were fully developed, it would afford sustenance to five times as great a number of inhabitants as the entire mass of human beings existing at present upon the globe. The new continent, he thinks, though less than half the size of the old, contains an equal quantity of useful soil, and much more than an equal amount of productive power. Be this as it may, we may safely conclude that the amount of human population now existing constitutes but a small proportion of that which the globe is capable of supporting, or which it is destined to sustain at no distant period, by the rapid progress of society, especially in America, Australia, and certain parts of the old continent.

Population that the Earth can support.—A modern writer has estimated that in America, there are over four million square miles of usable land, each capable of supporting 200 people; and nearly six million, each mile capable of supporting 490 people.983 If this idea is correct, it follows, as that author points out, that if the natural resources of America were fully developed, it could sustain five times the number of people that currently exist on the planet. The new continent, he believes, although less than half the size of the old, contains an equal amount of usable land and much more productive capacity. Regardless, we can confidently conclude that the current human population represents just a small fraction of what the Earth can support, or what it is likely to sustain in the near future due to the rapid advancement of society, especially in America, Australia, and certain regions of the old continent.

Power of exterminating species no prerogative of man.—But if we reflect that many millions of square miles of the most fertile land, occupied originally by a boundless variety of animal and vegetable forms, have been already brought under the dominion of man, and compelled, in a great measure, to yield nourishment to him, and to a limited number of plants and animals which he has caused to increase, we must at once be convinced, that the annihilation of a multitude of species has already been effected, and will continue to go on hereafter, in certain regions, in a still more rapid ratio, as the colonies of highly civilized nations spread themselves over unoccupied lands.

The ability to exterminate species isn’t solely a human right.—However, if we consider that countless square miles of the most fertile land, originally home to a vast variety of animal and plant life, have already come under human control and are largely forced to provide food for us and a limited number of plants and animals we have cultivated, we must acknowledge that many species have already been wiped out and will continue to be lost in the future, especially as the colonies of advanced nations expand into untouched territories.

Yet, if we wield the sword of extermination as we advance, we have no reason to repine at the havoc committed, nor to fancy, with the Scottish 688 poet, that "we violate the social union of nature;" or complain, with the melancholy Jacques, that we

Yet, if we use the sword of destruction as we move forward, we have no reason to regret the chaos caused, nor to believe, with the Scottish poet, that "we violate the social union of nature;" or to complain, like the sad Jacques, that we

Are just usurpers, tyrants, and what's even worse, To scare the animals and kill them. In their assigned and native home.

We have only to reflect, that in thus obtaining possession of the earth by conquest, and defending our acquisitions by force, we exercise no exclusive prerogative. Every species which has spread itself from a small point over a wide area must, in like manner, have marked its progress by the diminution or the entire extirpation of some other, and must maintain its ground by a successful struggle against the encroachments of other plants and animals. That minute parasitic plant, called "the rust" in wheat, has, like the Hessian fly, the locust, and the aphis, caused famines ere now amongst the "lords of the creation." The most insignificant and diminutive species, whether in the animal or vegetable kingdom, have each slaughtered their thousands, as they disseminated themselves over the globe, as well as the lion, when first it spread itself over the tropical regions of Africa.

We just need to think about the fact that by taking control of the earth through conquest and protecting our gains through force, we aren't exercising any special privilege. Every species that has expanded from a small area to cover a large one has similarly shown its advancement by reducing or completely eliminating other species and must hold its territory by successfully fighting against the advances of other plants and animals. That tiny parasitic plant known as "the rust" in wheat has, like the Hessian fly, the locust, and the aphis, caused famines in the past among the "lords of creation." Even the smallest and least significant species, whether animal or plant, have each caused thousands of deaths as they spread across the globe, just like the lion did when it first moved into the tropical regions of Africa.

Concluding remarks.—Although we have as yet considered one class only of the causes (the organic) by which species may become exterminated, yet it cannot but appear evident that the continued action of these alone, throughout myriads of future ages, must work an entire change in the state of the organic creation, not merely on the continents and islands, where the power of man is chiefly exerted, but in the great ocean, where his control is almost unknown. The mind is prepared by the contemplation of such future revolutions to look for the signs of others, of an analogous nature, in the monuments of the past. Instead of being astonished at the proofs there manifested of endless mutations in the animate world, they will appear to one who has thought profoundly on the fluctuations now in progress, to afford evidence in favor of the uniformity of the system, unless, indeed, we are precluded from speaking of uniformity when we characterize a principle of endless variation.

Concluding remarks.—Although we have only looked at one category of causes (the organic) that can lead to species extinction, it's clear that if these causes continue to operate over countless future ages, they will completely change the state of organic life. This change will occur not only on continents and islands, where humans have the most influence, but also in the vast ocean, where human impact is nearly nonexistent. Reflecting on such future changes prepares the mind to recognize similar signs in the remnants of the past. Instead of being shocked by the evidence of constant changes in living organisms, those who have deeply contemplated the ongoing fluctuations will see this evidence as supporting the consistency of the system, unless we argue that we can't refer to uniformity when describing a principle of endless variation.


CHAPTER XLII.

EXTINCTION OF SPECIES.—INFLUENCE OF INORGANIC CAUSES.

Powers of diffusion indispensable, that each species may maintain its ground—How changes in physical geography affect the distribution of species—Rate of the change of species due to this cause cannot be uniform—Every change in the physical geography of large regions tends to the extinction of species—Effects of a general alteration of climate on the migration of species—Gradual refrigeration would cause species in the northern and southern hemispheres to become distinct—Elevation of temperature the reverse—Effects on the condition of species which must result from inorganic changes inconsistent with the theory of transmutation.

Powers of diffusion are essential for each species to hold its ground—How shifts in physical geography influence the distribution of species—The rate of species change due to this factor can’t be consistent—Every shift in the physical geography of large areas leads to the extinction of species—The impact of a general climate change on species migration—Gradual cooling would make species in the northern and southern hemispheres become distinct—Rising temperatures would have the opposite effect—The implications for species conditions that must arise from inorganic changes contradict the theory of transformation.

Powers of diffusion indispensable, that each species may maintain its ground.—Having shown in the last chapter, how considerably the numerical increase or the extension of the geographical range of any one species must derange the numbers and distribution of others, let us now direct our attention to the influence which the inorganic causes described in the second book are continually exerting on the habitations of species.

Essential powers of diffusion, so that each species can hold its ground.—After demonstrating in the last chapter how significantly the population growth or geographic expansion of any one species can disrupt the numbers and distribution of others, let’s now focus on the impact that the inorganic factors discussed in the second book constantly have on the habitats of species.

So great is the instability of the earth's surface, that if nature were not continually engaged in the task of sowing seeds and colonizing animals, the depopulation of a certain portion of the habitable sea and land would in a few years be considerable. Whenever a river transports sediment into a lake or sea, so as materially to diminish its depth, the aquatic animals and plants which delight in deep water are expelled: the tract, however, is not allowed to remain useless; but is soon peopled by species which require more light and heat, and thrive where the water is shallow. Every addition made to the land by the encroachment of the delta of a river banishes many subaqueous species from their native abodes; but the new-formed plain is not permitted to lie unoccupied, being instantly covered with terrestrial vegetation. The ocean devours continuous lines of sea-coasts, and precipitates forests or rich pasture land into the waves: but this space is not lost to the animate creation; for shells and sea-weeds soon adhere to the new-made cliffs, and numerous fish people the channel which the current has scooped out for itself. No sooner has a volcanic island been thrown up than some lichens begin to grow upon it, and it is sometimes clothed with verdure while smoke and ashes are still occasionally thrown from the crater. The cocoa, pandanus, and mangrove take root upon the coral reef before it has fairly risen above the waves. The burning stream of lava that descends from Etna rolls through the stately forest, and converts to ashes every tree and herb which stands in its way; but the black strip of land thus desolated is covered again in the course of time, with oaks, pines, and chestnuts, as luxuriant as those which the fiery torrent swept away.

The instability of the earth's surface is so great that if nature weren't constantly busy planting seeds and introducing animals, a significant part of the habitable land and sea would be empty in just a few years. Whenever a river carries sediment into a lake or sea, which reduces its depth, the aquatic animals and plants that thrive in deep water are pushed out. However, this area doesn't stay unproductive; it quickly gets filled with species that need more light and warmth and do well in shallow water. Every time land expands due to a river's delta, many underwater species lose their native habitats, but the newly formed land doesn't remain vacant—it rapidly becomes covered with land plants. The ocean continuously erodes coastlines, dragging forests or rich pasture into the waves, but this space isn't lost to living creatures. Shells and seaweed quickly attach to the new cliffs, and various fish inhabit the channel created by the current. As soon as a volcanic island rises, lichens start to grow on it, and it can even be blanketed in greenery while smoke and ashes occasionally erupt from the crater. Coconut palms, pandanus, and mangroves take root on the coral reef before it completely emerges from the waves. The flowing lava from Etna moves through the grand forest, turning every tree and plant in its path to ash, but the scorched land is eventually reclaimed over time, becoming lush again with oaks, pines, and chestnuts, just as abundant as those that the fiery flow destroyed.

690 Every flood and landslip, every wave which a hurricane or earthquake throws upon the shore, every shower of volcanic dust and ashes which buries a country far and wide to the depth of many feet, every advance of the sand-flood, every conversion of salt water into fresh when rivers alter their main channel of discharge, every permanent variation in the rise or fall of tides in an estuary—these and countless other causes displace, in the course of a few centuries, certain plants and animals from stations which they previously occupied. If, therefore, the Author of nature had not been prodigal of those numerous contrivances, before alluded to, for spreading all classes of organic beings over the earth—if he had not ordained that the fluctuations of the animate and inanimate creation should be in perfect harmony with each other, it is evident that considerable spaces, now the most habitable on the globe, would soon be as devoid of life as are the Alpine snows, or the dark abysses of the ocean, or the moving sands of the Sahara.

690 Every flood and landslide, every wave thrown onto the shore by a hurricane or earthquake, every fall of volcanic dust and ash that covers a land to great depths, every advance of shifting sands, every transition of saltwater into freshwater when rivers change their main flow, and every lasting change in the rise or fall of tides in an estuary—these and countless other factors displace, over the course of a few centuries, certain plants and animals from the places they once inhabited. If, therefore, the Creator of nature hadn’t been generous with those various methods for spreading all kinds of living things across the earth—if He hadn’t set up a system where the changes in living and non-living things are perfectly in sync—it’s clear that large areas, now some of the most populated on the planet, would quickly become as lifeless as the snowy Alps, the abyssal depths of the ocean, or the shifting sands of the Sahara.

The powers, then, of migration and diffusion conferred on animals and plants are indispensable to enable them to maintain their ground, and would be necessary, even though it were never intended that a species should gradually extend its geographical range. But a facility of shifting their quarters being once given, it cannot fail to happen that the inhabitants of one province should occasionally penetrate into some other; since the strongest of those barriers which I before described as separating distinct regions are all liable to be thrown down, one after the other, during the vicissitudes of the earth's surface.

The abilities of migration and spreading given to animals and plants are essential for them to hold their ground, and would be necessary even if there was never a plan for a species to gradually expand its geographical range. But once they have the ability to move around, it's inevitable that the inhabitants of one area will sometimes move into another; since the strongest barriers that I mentioned before as separating different regions can all eventually be broken down one by one due to the changes in the earth's surface.

How changes in physical Geography affect the distribution of species.—The numbers and distribution of particular species are affected in two ways, by changes in the physical geography of the earth:—First, these changes promote or retard the migrations of species; secondly, they alter the physical conditions of the localities which species inhabit. If the ocean should gradually wear its way through an isthmus, like that of Suez, it would open a passage for the intermixture of the aquatic tribes of two seas previously disjoined, and would, at the same time, close a free communication which the terrestrial plants and animals of two continents had before enjoyed. These would be, perhaps, the most important consequences, in regard to the distribution of species, which would result from the breach made by the sea in such a spot; but there would be others of a distinct nature, such as the conversion of a certain tract of land, which formed the isthmus, into sea. This space, previously occupied by terrestrial plants and animals, would be immediately delivered over to the aquatic; a local revolution which might have happened in innumerable other parts of the globe, without being attended by any alteration in the blending together of species of two distinct provinces.

How changes in physical geography affect the distribution of species.—The numbers and distribution of specific species are influenced in two ways by changes in the earth's physical geography: First, these changes can either encourage or hinder species migrations; second, they modify the physical conditions of the areas where species live. If the ocean slowly erodes an isthmus, like that of Suez, it would create a pathway for mixing aquatic species from two previously separated seas, while simultaneously cutting off the free movement that terrestrial plants and animals from two continents once enjoyed. These would likely be some of the most significant consequences regarding species distribution resulting from such an opening made by the sea; however, there would be other distinct effects, such as turning a piece of land that formed the isthmus into ocean. This area, once home to terrestrial plants and animals, would immediately become inhabited by aquatic species—a local change that could have occurred in countless other places around the globe without affecting the mixing of species from two different regions.

Rate of change of species cannot be uniform.—This observation leads me to point out one of the most interesting conclusions to which we are led by the contemplation of the vicissitudes of the inanimate world 691 in relation to those of the animate. It is clear that, if the agency of inorganic causes be uniform, as I have supposed, they must operate very irregularly on the state of organic beings, so that the rate according to which these will change in particular regions will not be equal in equal periods of time.

The rate at which species change can’t be consistent.—This observation leads me to highlight one of the most fascinating conclusions we can draw from examining the fluctuations of the inanimate world 691 compared to those of the living world. It’s clear that if inorganic factors are acting consistently, as I’ve suggested, they must influence the status of living beings very unevenly, meaning that the rate at which these beings change in specific areas won’t be the same over equal time periods.

I am not about to advocate the doctrine of general catastrophes recurring at certain intervals, as in the ancient Oriental cosmogonies, nor do I doubt that, if very considerable periods of equal duration could be compared one with another, the rate of change in the living, as well as in the inorganic world, might be nearly uniform; but if we regard each of the causes separately, which we know to be at present the most instrumental in remodelling the state of the surface, we shall find that we must expect each to be in action for thousands of years, without producing any extensive alterations in the habitable surface, and then to give rise, during a very brief period, to important revolutions.

I’m not going to support the idea that major disasters happen at regular intervals like in ancient Eastern creation stories. I also don’t doubt that if we looked at very long periods of equal length side by side, the rate of change in living things and the non-living world might be pretty consistent. However, if we consider each of the causes that are currently most influential in reshaping the Earth's surface, we’ll see that we should expect each one to act for thousands of years without causing significant changes in the habitable areas, and then lead to major changes during a very short period.

Illustration derived from subsidences.—I shall illustrate this principle by a few of the most remarkable examples which present themselves. In the course of the last century, as we have seen, a considerable number of instances are recorded of the solid surface, whether covered by water or not, having been permanently sunk or upraised by subterranean movements. Most of these convulsions are only accompanied by temporary fluctuations in the state of limited districts, and a continued repetition of these events for thousands of years might not produce any decided change in the state of many of those great zoological or botanical provinces of which I have sketched the boundaries.

Illustration derived from collapses.—I will explain this principle with a few of the most notable examples that come to mind. Over the last century, we've seen many records of solid surfaces, whether they were covered by water or not, being permanently lowered or raised due to underground movements. Most of these upheavals are only accompanied by temporary changes in certain areas, and a continuous occurrence of these events over thousands of years might not result in any significant change in the conditions of many of the large zoological or botanical regions I've outlined.

When, for example, large parts of the ocean and even of inland seas are a thousand fathoms or upwards in depth, it is a matter of no moment to the animate creation that vast tracts should be heaved up many fathoms at certain intervals, or should subside to the same amount. Neither can any material revolution be produced in South America either in the terrestrial or the marine plants or animals by a series of shocks on the coast of Chili, each of which, like that of Penco, in 1751, should uplift the coast about twenty-five feet. Nor if the ground sinks fifty feet at a time, as in the harbor of Port Royal, in Jamaica, in 1692, will such alterations of level work any general fluctuations in the state of organic beings inhabiting the West Indian Islands, or the Caribbean Sea.

When large parts of the ocean and even inland seas are a thousand fathoms deep or more, it doesn’t matter to living creatures if vast areas rise several fathoms at certain times or sink by the same amount. Also, no significant change can occur in South America, whether in land or sea plants or animals, due to a series of earthquakes along the coast of Chile, each of which, like the one in Penco in 1751, causes the coast to rise about twenty-five feet. Similarly, if the ground drops fifty feet at a time, like in the harbor of Port Royal, Jamaica, in 1692, such changes in level won't create any major shifts in the state of the living things in the West Indian Islands or the Caribbean Sea.

It is only when the subterranean powers, by shifting gradually the points where their principal force is developed, happen to strike upon some particular region where a slight change of level immediately affects the distribution of land and water, or the state of the climate, or the barriers between distinct groups of species over extensive areas, that the rate of fluctuation becomes accelerated, and may, in the course of a few years or centuries, work mightier changes than had been experienced in myriads of antecedent years.

It’s only when the underground forces gradually shift the areas where their main strength is focused that they hit a specific region where even a small change in elevation can immediately impact how land and water are distributed, the climate, or the barriers between different species over large areas. That’s when the rate of change speeds up, and in just a few years or centuries, it can cause more significant changes than what had happened in countless years before.

Thus, for example, a repetition of subsidences causing the narrow isthmus of Panama to sink down a few hundred feet, would, in a few centuries, bring about a great revolution in the state of the animate creation 692 in the western hemisphere. Thousands of aquatic species would pass, for the first time, from the Caribbean Sea into the Pacific; and thousands of others, before peculiar to the Pacific Ocean, would make their way into the Caribbean Sea, the Gulf of Mexico, and the Atlantic. A considerable modification would probably be occasioned by the same event in the direction or volume of the Gulf stream, and thereby the temperature of the sea and the contiguous lands might be altered as far as the influence of that current extends. A change of climate might thus be produced in the ocean from Florida to Spitzbergen, and in many countries of North America, Europe, and Greenland. Not merely the heat, but the quantity of rain which falls, would be altered in certain districts, so that many species would be excluded from tracts where they before flourished: others would be reduced in number; and some would thrive more and multiply. The seeds also and the fruits of plants would no longer be drifted in precisely the same directions, nor the eggs of aquatic animals; neither would species be any longer impeded in their migrations towards particular stations before shut out from them by their inability to cross the mighty current.

So, for instance, if the subsidence of the land caused the narrow isthmus of Panama to sink several hundred feet, over a few centuries, it would lead to a major shift in animal life in the western hemisphere. Thousands of aquatic species would move from the Caribbean Sea into the Pacific for the first time, while thousands of others, previously exclusive to the Pacific Ocean, would flow into the Caribbean Sea, the Gulf of Mexico, and the Atlantic. This event would likely also alter the course or strength of the Gulf Stream, which could change sea temperatures and affect the neighboring lands depending on how far that current reaches. Such a climate change could occur in the ocean from Florida to Spitzbergen and impact various countries in North America, Europe, and Greenland. Not only would the temperature change, but the amount of rainfall in certain areas would also be affected, leading to the decline of some species in regions where they once thrived, while others would see their numbers decrease or even thrive and multiply. The seeds and fruits of plants wouldn’t drift in exactly the same directions anymore, nor would the eggs of aquatic animals; species would no longer be blocked from migrating to certain areas that were previously inaccessible due to their inability to cross the strong current.

Let us take another example from a part of the globe which is at present liable to suffer by earthquakes, namely, the low sandy tract which intervenes between the sea of Azof and the Caspian. If there should occur a sinking down to a trifling amount, and such ravines should be formed as might be produced by a few earthquakes, not more considerable than have fallen within our limited observation during the last 150 years, the waters of the Sea of Azof would pour rapidly into the Caspian, which, according to the measurements lately made by the Academy of St. Petersburg, is 84 feet below the level of the Black Sea.984 The Sea of Azof would immediately borrow from the Black Sea, that sea again from the Mediterranean, and the Mediterranean from the Atlantic, so that an inexhaustible current would pour down into the low tracts of Asia bordering the Caspian, by which all the sandy salt steppes adjacent to that sea would be inundated. An area of several thousand square leagues, now below the level of the Mediterranean, would be converted from land into sea.

Let's consider another example from a region that is currently prone to earthquakes, specifically the low sandy area between the Sea of Azov and the Caspian Sea. If there were a slight sinking of the ground, and if ravines were formed by a few earthquakes not more significant than those we've observed in the last 150 years, the waters of the Sea of Azov would quickly flow into the Caspian Sea, which, according to recent measurements by the Academy of St. Petersburg, is 84 feet below the level of the Black Sea.984 The Sea of Azov would then draw from the Black Sea, the Black Sea from the Mediterranean, and the Mediterranean from the Atlantic, creating an unending current that would flood the lowlands of Asia bordering the Caspian, inundating all the sandy salt steppes near that sea. An area of several thousand square leagues, currently below the level of the Mediterranean, would turn from land into sea.

Illustration derived from the elevation of land.—Let us next imagine a few cases of the elevation of land of small extent at certain critical points, as, for example, in the shallowest part of the Straits of Gibraltar, where the deepest soundings from the African to the European side give only 220 fathoms. In proportion as this submarine barrier of rock was upheaved, the whole channel would be contracted in width and depth, and the volume of water which the current constantly flowing from the Atlantic pours into the Mediterranean would be lessened. But the loss of the inland sea by evaporation would remain the same; so that being no longer able to draw on the ocean for a supply sufficient to restore its equilibrium, it must sink, and leave dry a certain portion of land around 693 its borders. The current which now flows constantly out of the Black Sea into the Mediterranean would then rush in more rapidly, and the level of the Mediterranean would be thereby prevented from falling so low; but the level of the Black Sea would, for the same reason, sink; so that when, by a continued series of elevatory movements, the Straits of Gibraltar had become completely closed up, we might expect large and level sandy steppes to surround both the Black Sea and Mediterranean, like those occurring at present on the skirts of the Caspian and the Lake of Aral. The geographical range of hundreds of aquatic species would be thereby circumscribed, and that of hundreds of terrestrial plants and animals extended.

Illustration derived from the elevation of land.—Now, let’s imagine a few scenarios where small areas of land rise at key points, such as in the shallowest part of the Straits of Gibraltar, where the deepest measurements from the African side to the European side show only 220 fathoms. As this underwater rock barrier rises, the entire channel would become narrower and shallower, reducing the amount of water that the current continuously flows from the Atlantic into the Mediterranean. However, the evaporation loss from the inland sea would stay the same; therefore, being unable to draw enough water from the ocean to maintain its balance, the Mediterranean would have to lower, leaving some land dry around its edges. The current that is now constantly flowing from the Black Sea into the Mediterranean would rush in faster, helping to prevent the Mediterranean’s level from dropping too low, but the Black Sea’s level would fall for the same reason. So, when the Straits of Gibraltar were completely closed off due to ongoing uplift, we might expect large, flat sandy plains to surround both the Black Sea and the Mediterranean, similar to those found today on the edges of the Caspian Sea and the Aral Sea. The geographical range of numerous aquatic species would be limited, while the range of many terrestrial plants and animals would expand.

A line of submarine volcanos crossing the channel of some strait, and gradually choking it up with ashes and lava, might produce a new barrier as effectually as a series of earthquakes; especially if thermal springs, charged with carbonate of lime, silica, and other mineral ingredients, should promote the rapid multiplication of corals and shells, and cement them together with solid matter precipitated during the intervals between eruptions. Suppose in this manner a stoppage to be caused of the Bahama channel between the bank of that name and the coast of Florida. This insignificant revolution, confined to a mere spot in the bottom of the ocean, would, by diverting the main current of the Gulf stream, give rise to extensive changes in the climate and distribution of animals and plants inhabiting the northern hemisphere.

A line of underwater volcanoes crossing the channel of a strait and gradually filling it up with ash and lava could create a new barrier just as effectively as a series of earthquakes; especially if hot springs filled with lime, silica, and other minerals helped corals and shells multiply quickly, cementing them together with solid material deposited during breaks between eruptions. Imagine if this caused a blockage in the Bahama channel between the bank of that name and the coast of Florida. This small change, limited to just a tiny area on the ocean floor, could redirect the main current of the Gulf Stream, leading to significant shifts in the climate and the distribution of animals and plants in the northern hemisphere.

Illustration from the formation of new islands.—A repetition of elevatory movements of earthquakes might continue over an area as extensive as Europe, for thousands of ages, at the bottom of the ocean, in certain regions, and produce no visible effects; whereas, if they should operate in some shallow parts of the Pacific, amid the coral archipelagos, they would soon give birth to a new continent. Hundreds of volcanic islands may be thrown up, and become covered with vegetation, without causing more than local fluctuations in the animate world; but if a chain like the Aleutian archipelago, or the Kurile Isles, run for a distance of many hundred miles, so as to form an almost uninterrupted communication between two continents, or two distant islands, the migrations of plants, birds, insects, and even of some quadrupeds, may cause, in a short time, an extraordinary series of revolutions tending to augment the range of some animals and plants, and to limit that of others. A new archipelago might be formed in the Mediterranean, the Bay of Biscay, and a thousand other places, and might produce less important events than one rock which should rise up between Australia and Java, so placed that winds and currents might cause an interchange of the plants, insects, and birds.

Illustration from the formation of new islands.—Repeated uplifting movements from earthquakes could occur over a vast area like Europe for thousands of years at the bottom of the ocean in certain regions without creating any visible effects; however, if they were to happen in some shallow parts of the Pacific, surrounded by coral islands, they could quickly give rise to a new continent. Numerous volcanic islands might emerge and become covered in vegetation without causing more than local changes in the living world; but if a chain like the Aleutian archipelago or the Kurile Isles extended for hundreds of miles, creating nearly uninterrupted connectivity between two continents or distant islands, the movement of plants, birds, insects, and even some mammals could lead to significant changes that expand the range of some species while limiting that of others. A new archipelago could form in the Mediterranean, the Bay of Biscay, or a thousand other locations and could have less impact than a single island that rises up between Australia and Java, positioned so that winds and currents could facilitate the exchange of plants, insects, and birds.

From the wearing through of an isthmus.—If we turn from the igneous to the aqueous agents, we find the same tendency to an irregular rate of change, naturally connected with the strictest uniformity in the energy of those causes. When the sea, for example, gradually encroaches upon both sides of a narrow isthmus, as that of Sleswick, separating the 694 North Sea from the Baltic, where, as before stated, the cliffs on both the opposite coasts are wasting away985, no material alteration results for thousands of years, save only that there is a progressive conversion of a small strip of land into water. A few feet only, or a few yards, are annually removed; but if, at last, the partition should be broken down, and the tides of the ocean should enter by a direct passage into the inland sea, instead of going by a circuitous route through the Cattegat, a body of salt water would sweep up as far as the Gulfs of Bothnia and Finland, the waters of which are now brackish, or almost fresh; and this revolution would be attended by the local annihilation of many species.

From the wearing through of an isthmus.—If we shift our focus from volcanic activity to water-related processes, we notice a similar pattern of irregular change linked to a consistent level of energy from these forces. Take the example of the sea gradually taking over both sides of a narrow isthmus, like the one in Sleswick, which separates the North Sea from the Baltic. As mentioned earlier, the cliffs on both opposite coasts are slowly eroding694, and for thousands of years, there’s little significant change, except for the gradual transformation of a small area of land into water. Only a few feet or a few yards are eroded each year; however, if eventually the separation becomes compromised and ocean tides can directly flow into the inland sea instead of taking a longer route through the Cattegat, saltwater would surge up into the gulfs of Bothnia and Finland, which currently have brackish or nearly fresh water. This shift would result in the local extinction of many species.

Similar consequences must have resulted on a small scale, when the sea opened its way through the Isthmus of Staveren in the thirteenth century, forming a union between an inland lake and the ocean, and opening, in the course of one century, a shallow strait, more than half as wide as the narrowest part of that which divides England from France.

Similar effects must have happened on a smaller scale when the sea broke through the Isthmus of Staveren in the thirteenth century, connecting an inland lake with the ocean and creating, over the course of a century, a shallow strait that was more than half as wide as the narrowest part that separates England from France.

Changes in physical geography which must occasion extinction of species.—It will almost seem superfluous, after I have thus traced the important modifications in the condition of living beings which flow from changes of trifling extent, to argue that entire revolutions might be brought about, if the climate and physical geography of the whole globe were greatly altered. It has been stated, that species are in general local, some being confined to extremely small spots, and depending for their existence on a combination of causes, which, if they are to be met with elsewhere, occur only in some very remote region. Hence it must happen that, when the nature of these localities is changed, the species will perish; for it will rarely happen that the cause which alters the character of the district will afford new facilities to the species to establish itself elsewhere.

Changes in physical geography that can lead to extinction of species.—It might seem unnecessary, after detailing the significant changes in the conditions of living beings caused by relatively minor alterations, to argue that complete transformations could occur if the climate and physical geography of the entire planet were significantly changed. It has been noted that species are generally localized, with some restricted to very small areas and relying on a specific combination of factors that, if found elsewhere, occur only in very distant places. Therefore, when the nature of these local environments changes, the species will likely die out; it is rare that the factors transforming the area will provide new opportunities for the species to thrive elsewhere.

African deserts.—If we attribute the origin of a great part of the desert of Africa to the gradual progress of moving sands driven eastward by the westerly winds, we may safely infer that a variety of species must have been annihilated by this cause alone. The sand-flood has been inundating, from time immemorial, some of the rich lands on the west of the Nile; and we have only to multiply this effect a sufficient number of times in order to understand how, in the lapse of ages, a whole group of terrestrial animals and plants may become extinct.

African deserts.—If we believe that a significant part of the African desert originated from the gradual movement of sands pushed eastward by westerly winds, we can confidently conclude that many species must have been wiped out because of this alone. For ages, the sand has been overwhelming some of the fertile lands west of the Nile; we only need to consider this effect multiplied over a long period to grasp how an entire group of land animals and plants can become extinct.

The African desert, without including Bornou and Darfour, extends, according to the calculation of Humboldt, over 194,000 square leagues; an area nearly three times as great as that of France. In a small portion of so vast a space, we may infer from analogy that there were many peculiar species of plants and animals which must have been banished by the sand, and their habitations invaded by the camel, and by birds and insects formed for the arid sands.

The African desert, excluding Bornou and Darfour, covers, according to Humboldt's estimate, around 194,000 square leagues; that’s almost three times the size of France. In just a small part of such a vast area, we can assume that there were many unique species of plants and animals that must have been driven out by the sand, with their homes taken over by camels, and by birds and insects adapted to the dry sands.

There is evidently nothing in the nature of the catastrophe to favor the escape of the former inhabitants to some adjoining province; nothing 695 to weaken, in the bordering lands, that powerful barrier against emigration—pre-occupancy. Nor, even if the exclusion of a certain group of species from a given tract were compensated by an extension of their range over a new country, would that circumstance tend to the conservation of species in general; for the extirpation would merely then be transferred to the region so invaded. If it be imagined, for example, that the aboriginal quadrupeds, birds, and other animals of Africa, emigrated in consequence of the advance of drift-sand, and colonized Arabia, the indigenous Arabian species must have given way before them, and have been reduced in number or destroyed.

There’s clearly nothing about the disaster that would help the former inhabitants escape to a nearby area; nothing 695 to diminish the strong barrier against moving out—occupancy. Even if a certain group of species left a specific area but then expanded their range into a new country, that wouldn’t help conserve species as a whole; instead, it would just shift the extinction to the new region they invaded. For instance, if we assume that the native mammals, birds, and other animals of Africa migrated because of advancing sand and settled in Arabia, the local Arabian species would have had to give way to them, decreasing in number or being wiped out.

Let us next suppose that, in some central or more elevated parts of the great African desert, the upheaving power of subterranean movements should be exerted throughout an immense series of ages, accompanied, at certain intervals, by volcanic eruptions, such as gave rise at once, in 1755, to a mountain 1600 feet high, on the Mexican plateau. When the continued repetition of these events had caused a mountain-chain, it is obvious that a complete transformation in the state of the climate would be brought about throughout a vast area.

Let’s imagine that, in some central or higher areas of the vast African desert, underground movements have been pushing up the land over a long period of time, with volcanic eruptions happening occasionally, similar to the one in 1755 that created a mountain 1,600 feet high on the Mexican plateau. When these events keep happening and form a mountain range, it’s clear that there would be a significant change in the climate across a large region.

We may imagine the summits of the new chain to rise so high as to be covered, like Mount Atlas, for several thousand feet, with snow, during a great part of the year. The melting of these snows, during the greatest heat, would cause the rivers to swell in the season when the greatest drought now prevails; the waters, moreover, derived from this source, would always be of lower temperature than the surrounding atmosphere, and would thus contribute to cool the climate. During the numerous earthquakes and volcanic eruptions supposed to accompany the gradual formation of the chain, there would be many floods caused by the bursting of temporary lakes, and by the melting of snows by lava. These inundations might deposit alluvial matter far and wide over the original sands, as the country assumed varied shapes, and was modified again and again by the moving power from below, and the aqueous erosion of the surface above. At length the Sahara might be fertilized, irrigated by rivers and streamlets intersecting it in every direction, and covered by jungle and morasses; so that the animals and plants which now people Northern Africa would disappear, and the region would gradually become fitted for the reception of a population of species perfectly dissimilar in their forms, habits, and organization.

We can imagine the peaks of the new mountain range rising high enough to be covered in snow, like Mount Atlas, for many thousands of feet for most of the year. The melting snow during the hottest part of the year would cause the rivers to swell during what is currently the driest season. Additionally, the water from this melting snow would be cooler than the surrounding air, helping to cool the climate. During the many earthquakes and volcanic eruptions expected as the mountain range forms, there would be numerous floods from temporary lakes bursting and from lava melting the snow. These floods could spread sediment across the original sands as the land changed shape repeatedly due to underground forces and surface erosion from water. Eventually, the Sahara could become fertile, irrigated by rivers and streams crisscrossing it, and covered in jungles and marshes. As a result, the animals and plants currently found in Northern Africa might disappear, and the area would gradually be transformed to support a diverse new population of species with completely different shapes, habits, and structures.

There are always some peculiar and characteristic features in the physical geography of each large division of the globe; and on these peculiarities the state of animal and vegetable life is dependent. If, therefore, we admit incessant fluctuations in the physical geography, we must, at the same time, concede the successive extinction of terrestrial and aquatic species to be part of the economy of our system. When some great class of stations is in excess in certain latitudes, as, for example, in wide savannahs, arid sands, lofty mountains, or inland seas, we find a corresponding development of species adapted for such circumstances. In North America, where there is a chain of vast inland lakes of fresh 696 water, we find an extraordinary abundance and variety of aquatic birds, fresh-water fish, testacea, and small amphibious reptiles, fitted for such a climate. The greater part of these would perish if the lakes were destroyed,—an event that might be brought about by some of the least of those important revolutions contemplated in geology. It might happen that no fresh-water lakes of corresponding magnitude might then exist on the globe; or that, if they occurred elsewhere, they might be situated in New Holland, Southern Africa, Eastern Asia, or some region so distant as to be quite inaccessible to the North American species; or they might be situated within the tropics, in a climate uninhabitable by creatures fitted for a temperate zone; or, finally, we may presume that they would be pre-occupied by indigenous tribes.

There are always unique and distinct features in the physical geography of each major region of the world, and these specific traits influence the state of animal and plant life. Therefore, if we acknowledge continuous changes in physical geography, we must also accept that the gradual extinction of land and water species is a part of our system's dynamics. When a significant category of stations is abundant in certain latitudes, like in vast savannahs, dry sands, tall mountains, or interior seas, we see a corresponding growth of species adapted to those conditions. In North America, where there's a series of large inland lakes of fresh 696 water, there's an extraordinary variety and number of water birds, freshwater fish, shellfish, and small amphibious reptiles suited for such a climate. Most of these would not survive if the lakes were destroyed—a change that could be caused by some of the smaller significant shifts considered in geology. It might happen that no fresh-water lakes of similar size would then exist on Earth; or if they were found in other places, they might be in Australia, Southern Africa, Eastern Asia, or some area so far away that it would be completely inaccessible to North American species; or they could be located in the tropics, in a climate unsuitable for creatures adapted to a temperate region; or, finally, we could assume that they would already be occupied by indigenous tribes.

A vivid description has been given by Mr. Darwin and Sir W. Parish of the great droughts which have sometimes visited the Pampas of South America, for three or four years in succession, during which an incredible number of wild animals, cattle, horses, and birds, have perished from want of food and water. Several hundred thousand animals were drowned in the Parana alone, having rushed into the river to drink, and being too much exhausted by hunger to escape.986 Such droughts are often attended in South America and other hot climates by wide-spreading conflagrations, caused by lightning, which fires the dried grass and brush-wood. Thus quadrupeds, birds, insects, and other creatures, are destroyed by myriads. How many species, both of the animal and vegetable world, which once flourished in the country between the valley of the Parana and the Straits of Magellan, may not have been annihilated, since the first drought or first conflagration began!

A vivid description has been provided by Mr. Darwin and Sir W. Parish of the intense droughts that occasionally affect the Pampas of South America, lasting three or four years in a row, during which an astonishing number of wild animals, cattle, horses, and birds have died from lack of food and water. Several hundred thousand animals drowned in the Parana alone, having rushed into the river to drink, but being too weak from hunger to escape.986 These droughts are often accompanied in South America and other hot climates by widespread fires caused by lightning, igniting the dry grass and brush. As a result, countless quadrupeds, birds, insects, and other creatures are destroyed. How many species, both animal and plant, that once thrived in the area between the valley of the Parana and the Straits of Magellan may have been wiped out since the first drought or fire began!

To pursue this train of reasoning farther is unnecessary; the geologist has only to reflect on what has been said of the habitations and stations of organic beings in general, and to consider them in relation to those effects which were contemplated in the second book, as resulting from the igneous and aqueous causes now in action, and he will immediately perceive that, amidst the vicissitudes of the earth's surface, species cannot be immortal, but must perish, one after the other, like the individuals which compose them. There is no possibility of escaping from this conclusion, without resorting to some hypothesis as violent as that of Lamarck, who imagined, as we have before seen, that species are each of them endowed with indefinite powers of modifying their organization, in conformity to the endless changes of circumstances to which they are exposed.

To take this line of thinking further is unnecessary; the geologist just needs to think about what has been mentioned regarding the habitats and locations of living beings in general, and relate them to the effects discussed in the second book, which stem from the ongoing volcanic and water-related causes. He will quickly see that, amid the changes in the earth's surface, species cannot be eternal, but must die off one after another, just like the individuals they consist of. There’s no way to avoid this conclusion without resorting to an explanation as extreme as that of Lamarck, who suggested, as we have seen before, that each species has unlimited abilities to change its structure based on the constant changes in the conditions they face.

Effects of a general Alteration in Climate on the Distribution of Species.

Some of the effects which must attend every general alteration of climate are sufficiently peculiar to claim a separate consideration before concluding the present chapter.

Some of the effects that come with any major change in climate are unique enough to deserve a separate discussion before we finish this chapter.

697 I have before stated that, during seasons of extraordinary severity, many northern birds, and in some countries many quadrupeds, migrate southwards. If these cold seasons were to become frequent, in consequence of a gradual and general refrigeration of the atmosphere, such migrations would be more and more regular, until, at length, many animals, now confined to the arctic regions, would become the tenants of the temperate zone; while the inhabitants of the temperate zone would approach nearer to the equator. At the same time, many species previously established on high mountains would begin to descend, in every latitude, towards the middle regions; and those which were confined to the flanks of mountains would make their way into the plains. Analogous changes would also take place in the vegetable kingdom.

697 I've previously mentioned that during extremely harsh seasons, many northern birds, and in some places, many mammals, migrate south. If these cold seasons become more common due to a gradual overall cooling of the atmosphere, such migrations would become increasingly regular, until eventually, many animals now living in the arctic would start to inhabit the temperate zone, while those in the temperate zone would move closer to the equator. At the same time, many species that currently live in high mountains would begin to move down towards the middle regions at various latitudes, and those that live on the mountainsides would head into the plains. Similar changes would also occur in the plant kingdom.

If, on the contrary, the heat of the atmosphere be on the increase, the plants and animals of low grounds would ascend to higher levels, the equatorial species would migrate into the temperate zone, and those of the temperate into the arctic circle.

If, on the other hand, the heat in the atmosphere is increasing, the plants and animals in low areas would move to higher altitudes, the species from the equator would migrate to the temperate zone, and those from the temperate zone would move into the Arctic Circle.

But although some species might thus be preserved, every great change of climate must be fatal to many which can find no place of retreat when their original habitations become unfit for them. For if the general temperature be on the rise, then there is no cooler region whither the polar species can take refuge; if it be on the decline, then the animals and plants previously established between the tropics have no resource. Suppose the general heat of the atmosphere to increase, so that even the arctic region became too warm for the musk-ox, and rein-deer, it is clear that they must perish; so if the torrid zone should lose so much of its heat, by the progressive refrigeration of the earth's surface, as to be an unfit habitation for apes, boas, bamboos, and palms, these tribes of animals and plants, or, at least; most of the species now belonging to them, would become extinct, for there would be no warmer latitudes for their reception.

But even though some species might survive, any major climate change is bound to be deadly for many that can't find a suitable refuge when their original habitats become unlivable. If the overall temperature rises, there’s nowhere cooler for polar species to escape; if it drops, then the animals and plants that thrive between the tropics have no alternatives. If we assume that the atmosphere's heat increases to the point where the Arctic becomes too warm for musk oxen and reindeer, it's obvious they would die off. Likewise, if the tropical zone loses enough heat due to the Earth's cooling surface to become an unsuitable home for apes, boas, bamboos, and palms, those groups of animals and plants—at least most of the species within them—would go extinct, as there would be no warmer regions for them to move to.

It will follow, therefore, that as often as the climates of the globe are passing from the extreme of heat to that of cold—from the summer to the winter of the great year before alluded to987—the migratory movement will be directed constantly from the poles towards the equator; and for this reason the species inhabiting parallel latitudes, in the northern and southern hemispheres, must become widely different. For I assume, on grounds before explained, that the original stock of each species is introduced into one spot of the earth only, and, consequently, no species can be at once indigenous in the arctic and antarctic circles.

It follows that whenever the world's climates transition from extreme heat to cold—from summer to winter during the lengthy cycles mentioned earlier987—the movement of species will consistently shift from the poles toward the equator. For this reason, the species found in similar latitudes in the northern and southern hemispheres must become significantly different. I assert, based on previous explanations, that the original population of each species is introduced to only one location on Earth, and thus, no species can be native to both the Arctic and Antarctic regions at the same time.

But when, on the contrary, a series of changes in the physical geography of the globe, or any other supposed cause, occasions an elevation of the general temperature,—when there is a passage from the winter to one of the vernal or summer seasons of the great cycle of climate,—then the order of the migratory movement is inverted. The different species of animals and plants direct their course from the equator towards the poles; 698 and the northern and southern hemispheres may become peopled to a certain limited extent by identical species.

But when, on the other hand, a series of changes in the physical geography of the planet, or any other supposed cause, leads to an increase in the overall temperature,—when there’s a transition from winter to one of the spring or summer seasons in the great climate cycle,—then the pattern of migration changes direction. Different species of animals and plants move from the equator toward the poles; 698 and the northern and southern hemispheres may become populated to some extent by the same species.

I say limited, because we cannot speculate on the entire transposition of a group of animals and plants from tropical to polar latitudes, or the reverse, as a probable or even possible event. We may believe the mean annual temperature of one zone to be transferable to another, but we know that the same climate cannot be so transferred. Whatever be the general temperature of the earth's surface, comparative equability of heat will characterize the tropical regions; while great periodical variations will belong to the temperate, and still more to the polar latitudes. These, and many other peculiarities connected with heat and light, depend on fixed astronomical causes, such as the motion of the earth and its position in relation to the sun, and not on those fluctuations of its surface which may influence the general temperature.

I say limited because we can’t just assume that a whole group of animals and plants can move from tropical to polar areas, or the other way around, as something likely or even possible. We might think that the average annual temperature of one zone can be applied to another, but we know that the same climate can't just be moved over. No matter what the overall temperature of the earth’s surface is, the tropical regions will have a relatively stable climate, while the temperate zones will experience significant seasonal changes, and even more so in the polar areas. These and many other features related to heat and light are determined by fixed astronomical factors, like the earth’s movement and its position in relation to the sun, rather than by the surface changes that might affect the general temperature.

Among many obstacles to such extensive transference of habitations, we must not forget the immense lapse of time required, according to the hypothesis before suggested, to bring about a considerable change in climate. During a period so vast, the other cause of extirpation, before enumerated, would exert so powerful an influence as to prevent all, save a very few hardy species, from passing from equatorial to polar regions, or from the tropics to the pole.988

Among the many challenges to such a widespread change in living environments, we must remember the long period of time needed, based on the previously suggested hypothesis, to create a significant shift in climate. Over such an extensive timeframe, the other cause of extinction mentioned earlier would have a strong impact, preventing all but a few tough species from moving from equatorial to polar regions, or from the tropics to the poles.988

But the power of accommodation to new circumstances is great in certain species, and might enable many to pass from one zone to another, if the mean annual heat of the atmosphere and the ocean were greatly altered. To the marine tribes, especially, such a passage would be possible; for they are less impeded in their migrations by barriers of land, than are the terrestrial by the ocean. Add to this, that the temperature of the ocean is much more uniform than that of the atmosphere investing the land; so that we may easily suppose that most of the testacea, fish, and other classes, might pass from the equatorial into the temperate regions, if the mean temperature of those regions were transposed, although a second expatriation of these species of tropical origin into the arctic and antarctic circles would probably be impossible.

But certain species have a great ability to adapt to new situations, which could allow many to move from one zone to another if the average annual temperature of the atmosphere and ocean changed significantly. This would be especially feasible for marine species, as they face fewer land barriers during migrations compared to terrestrial species that need to cross the ocean. Additionally, the ocean’s temperature is much more consistent than the air temperature over land; therefore, it's reasonable to think that many mollusks, fish, and other groups could move from equatorial to temperate regions if the average temperature in those areas shifted. However, a second migration of these tropical species into the Arctic and Antarctic regions would likely be impossible.

Let us now consider more particularly the effect of vicissitudes of climate in causing one species to give way before the increasing numbers of some other.

Let’s now take a closer look at how changes in climate can cause one species to be pushed out by the growing populations of another species.

When temperature forms the barrier which arrests the progress of an animal or plant in a particular direction, the individuals are fewer and less vigorous as they approach the extreme confines of the geographical range of the species. But these stragglers are ready to multiply rapidly on the slightest increase or diminution of heat that may be favorable to them, just as particular insects increase during a hot summer, and certain plants and animals gain ground after a series of congenial seasons.

When temperature creates a barrier that stops an animal or plant from moving in a particular direction, the individuals become fewer and less vigorous as they near the extreme limits of the species' geographical range. However, these outliers are quick to reproduce rapidly with even a small rise or drop in heat that benefits them, similar to how certain insects thrive during a hot summer, and how specific plants and animals prosper after a series of favorable seasons.

In almost every district, especially if it be mountainous, there are a 699 variety of species the limits of whose habitations are conterminous, some being unable to proceed farther without encountering too much heat, others too much cold. Individuals, which are thus on the borders of the regions proper to their respective species, are like the outposts of hostile armies, ready to profit by every slight change of circumstances in their favor, and to advance upon the ground occupied by their neighbors and opponents.

In almost every area, especially if it’s mountainous, there are a 699 variety of species whose living spaces overlap, with some unable to go further due to excessive heat and others due to too much cold. Individuals that are on the edge of the zones suitable for their species are like the front lines of rival armies, ready to take advantage of any small change in circumstances that works in their favor and to move into the territory occupied by their neighbors and competitors.

The proximity of distinct climates produced by the inequalities of the earth's surface, brings species possessing very different constitutions into such immediate contact, that their naturalizations are very speedy whenever opportunities of advancing present themselves. Many insects and plants, for example, are common to low plains within the arctic circle, and to lofty mountains in Scotland and other parts of Europe. If the climate, therefore, of the polar regions were transferred to our own latitudes, the species in question would immediately descend from these elevated stations to overrun the low grounds. Invasions of this kind, attended by the expulsion of the pre-occupants, are almost instantaneous, because the change of temperature not only places the one species in a more favorable position, but renders the others sickly and almost incapable of defence.

The closeness of different climates created by the unevenness of the earth's surface brings together species with very different traits so quickly that they adapt rapidly whenever opportunities to thrive arise. For example, many insects and plants can be found in low plains within the Arctic Circle and on high mountains in Scotland and other parts of Europe. So, if the climate of the polar regions were to be moved to our latitudes, these species would quickly descend from their high spots to spread out over the low areas. Such invasions, which push out the existing species, happen almost instantly because the temperature change not only gives one species a better chance but also weakens the others, making them sickly and nearly defenseless.

These changes inconsistent with the theory of transmutation.—Lamarck, when speculating on the transmutation of species, supposed every modification in organization and instinct to be brought about slowly and insensibly in an indefinite lapse of ages. But he does not appear to have sufficiently considered how much every alteration in the physical condition of the habitable surface changes the relations of a great number of co-existing species, and that some of these would be ready instantly to avail themselves of the slightest change in their favor, and to multiply to the injury of others. Even if we thought it possible that the palm or the elephant, which now flourish in equatorial regions, could ever learn to bear the variable seasons of our temperate zone, or the rigors of an arctic winter, we might with no less confidence affirm, that they must perish before they had time to become habituated to such new circumstances. That they would be displaced by other species as often as the climate varied, may be inferred from the data before explained respecting the local extermination of species produced by the multiplication of others.

These changes are inconsistent with the theory of transmutation.—Lamarck, while considering the evolution of species, believed that every change in structure and instinct happened slowly and subtly over an indefinite period. However, he doesn’t seem to have fully thought about how much any change in the physical environment affects the relationships between numerous coexisting species, and that some of these would be quick to take advantage of even the slightest favorable change and to reproduce at the expense of others. Even if we thought it possible that the palm tree or the elephant, which currently thrive in tropical areas, could adapt to the variable climates of our temperate zones or survive the harshness of an Arctic winter, we could equally assert that they would likely perish before they had the chance to get used to such new conditions. It can be inferred from the earlier discussion about the local extinction of species prompted by the growth of others that they would be replaced by different species whenever the climate changed.

Suppose the climate of the highest part of the woody zone of Etna to be transferred to the sea-shore of the base of the mountain, no botanist would anticipate that the olive, lemon-tree, and prickly pear (Cactus Opuntia) would be able to contend with the oak and chestnut, which would begin forthwith to descend to a lower level; or that these last would be able to stand their ground against the pine, which would also, in the space of a few years, begin to occupy a lower position. We might form some kind of estimate of the time which might be required for the migrations of these plants; whereas we have no data for concluding that any number of thousands of years would be sufficient for one step in the 700 pretended metamorphosis of one species into another, possessing distinct attributes and qualities.

If you moved the climate of the highest part of the wooded area on Etna to the shoreline at the base of the mountain, no botanist would expect that the olive, lemon tree, and prickly pear (Cactus Opuntia) could compete with the oak and chestnut, which would quickly start moving down to a lower elevation; or that the latter would be able to hold their ground against the pine, which would also, within a few years, begin to move to a lower spot. We could roughly estimate how long it might take for these plants to migrate; however, we have no information to suggest that thousands of years would be enough for a single step in the 700 supposed transformation of one species into another with clearly different traits and qualities.

This argument is applicable not merely to climate, but to any other cause of mutation. However slowly a lake may be converted into a marsh, or a marsh into a meadow, it is evident that before the lacustrine plants can acquire the power of living in marshes, or the marsh-plants of living in a less humid soil, other species, already existing in the region, and fitted for these several stations, will intrude and keep possession of the ground. So, if a tract of salt water becomes fresh by passing through every intermediate degree of brackishness, still the marine mollusks will never be permitted to be gradually metamorphosed into fluviatile species; because long before any such transformation can take place by slow and insensible degrees, other tribes, already formed to delight in brackish or fresh water, will avail themselves of the change in the fluid, and will, each in their turn, monopolize the space.

This argument applies not only to climate but to any other cause of change. No matter how slowly a lake turns into a marsh or a marsh transforms into a meadow, it's clear that before the aquatic plants can adapt to living in marshes, or the marsh plants to drier soil, other species that are already present in the area and suited for these environments will move in and take over. Similarly, if a body of salt water becomes fresh by gradually passing through varying levels of brackishness, the marine mollusks won't be able to gradually change into freshwater species. That's because long before any of this transformation can happen through slow and subtle changes, other groups that thrive in brackish or fresh water will take advantage of the shift in the water, each in their turn claiming the space.

It is idle, therefore, to dispute about the abstract possibility of the conversion of one species into another, when there are known causes so much more active in their nature, which must always intervene and prevent the actual accomplishment of such conversions. A faint image of the certain doom of a species less fitted to struggle with some new condition in a region which it previously inhabited, and where it has to contend with a more vigorous species, is presented by the extirpation of savage tribes of men by the advancing colony of some civilized nation. In this case the contest is merely between two different races—two varieties, moreover, of a species which exceeds all others in its aptitude to accommodate its habits to the most extraordinary variations of circumstances. Yet few future events are more certain than the speedy extermination of the Indians of North America and the savages of New Holland in the course of a few centuries, when these tribes will be remembered only in poetry or history.

It's pointless to argue about the theoretical possibility of one species turning into another when there are much more effective causes at play that will always prevent such transformations. A faint image of the inevitable demise of a species that is less equipped to deal with new conditions in an area it used to inhabit, where it has to compete with a stronger species, can be seen in how savage tribes are wiped out by the advancing colonies of civilized nations. In this situation, the struggle is simply between two different races—two variations of a species that excels in adapting its behaviors to incredibly varied circumstances. Yet, few outcomes are more certain than the rapid extinction of the Native Americans of North America and the indigenous people of New Holland over the next few centuries, when these tribes will only be remembered in poetry or history.


Concluding remarks.—We often hear astonishment expressed at the disappearance from the earth in times comparatively modern of many small as well as large animals, the remains of which have been found in a fossil state, under circumstances implying that neither any great geographical revolution, nor the exterminating influence of man has intervened to account for their extinction. But in all such cases we should inquire whether we are sufficiently acquainted with the numerous and complicated conditions on which the perpetuation of each species depends, to entitle us to wonder if it should be suddenly cut off.

Concluding remarks.—We often hear people express their surprise at the disappearance from the earth, in relatively recent times, of many small and large animals, the remains of which have been found in fossil form under conditions suggesting that neither significant geographical changes nor human extermination have caused their extinction. However, in such cases, we should ask ourselves whether we truly understand the many complicated factors that the survival of each species relies on, to justify our astonishment if it suddenly vanishes.

Mr. Darwin, when calling attention to the fact that the horse, megatherium, megalonyx, and many contemporary Mammalia, had perished in South America after that continent had acquired its present configuration, and when, if we may judge by the Testacea, the climate very nearly resembled the present, observes, "that in the living creation one species is often extremely rare in a given region, while another of the same genus and with closely allied habits is exceedingly common. A 701 zoologist familiar with such phenomena, if asked to explain them, usually replies, that some slight difference in climate, food, or the number of its enemies, must determine the relative strength of the two species in question, although we may be unable to point out the precise manner of the action of the check. We are, therefore, driven to the conclusion, that causes generally quite inappreciable by us determine whether a given species shall be abundant or scanty in numbers. Why, then, should we feel astonishment if the rarity is occasionally carried a step farther,—to extinction?"989

Mr. Darwin, highlighting the fact that the horse, megatherium, megalonyx, and many modern mammals went extinct in South America after the continent took on its current shape, notes that, judging by the Testacea, the climate likely resembled today’s quite closely. He observes, "in the living world, one species can be very rare in a specific area, while another of the same genus with similar habits can be very common. A zoologist familiar with these phenomena, when asked to explain them, usually says that some slight difference in climate, food, or the number of predators must influence the relative abundance of the two species involved, even though we might not be able to identify the exact manner in which these factors operate. Therefore, we have to conclude that causes typically imperceptible to us decide whether a species will be numerous or sparse. So, why should we be surprised if rarity sometimes takes the next step—leading to extinction?"989


CHAPTER XLIII.

EXTINCTION AND CREATION OF SPECIES.

Theory of the successive extinction of species consistent with a limited geographical distribution—Opinions of botanists respecting the centres from which plants have been diffused—Whether there are grounds for inferring that the loss, from time to time, of certain animals and plants, is compensated by the introduction of new species?—Whether any evidence of such new creations could be expected within the historical era?—The question whether the existing species have been created in succession must be decided by geological monuments.

Theory of the gradual extinction of species aligned with a limited geographic range—Views of botanists on the origins of plant distribution—Is there any reason to believe that the loss of certain animals and plants over time is balanced by the arrival of new species?—Can we expect to find any evidence of such new creations within recorded history?—The issue of whether current species were created in succession needs to be determined by geological records.

Successive Extinction of Species consistent with their limited Geographical Distribution.

In the preceding chapters I have pointed out the strict dependence of each species of animal and plant on certain physical conditions in the state of the earth's surface, and on the number and attributes of other organic beings inhabiting the same region. I have also endeavored to show that all these conditions are in a state of continual fluctuation, the igneous and aqueous agents remodelling, from time to time, the physical geography of the globe, and the migrations of species causing new relations to spring up successively between different organic beings. I have deduced as a corollary, that the species existing at any particular period, must, in the course of ages, become extinct one after the other. "They must die out," to borrow an emphatical expression from Buffon, "because Time fights against them."

In the earlier chapters, I pointed out how each species of animal and plant relies heavily on specific physical conditions on the Earth's surface, as well as on the number and characteristics of other living beings in the same area. I also tried to show that all these conditions are constantly changing, with volcanic and water processes reshaping the globe’s physical geography from time to time, and species migrations creating new relationships between different organisms over time. I've concluded that the species present at any given moment must eventually become extinct, one after another. "They must die out," to borrow a powerful phrase from Buffon, "because Time works against them."

If the views which I have taken are just, there will be no difficulty in explaining why the habitations of so many species are now restrained within exceedingly narrow limits. Every local revolution, such as those contemplated in the preceding chapter, tends to circumscribe the range of some species, while it enlarges that of others; and if we are 702 led to infer that new species originate in one spot only, each must require time to diffuse itself over a wide area. It will follow, therefore, from the adoption of this hypothesis, that the recent origin of some species, and the high antiquity of others, are equally consistent with the general fact of their limited distribution; some being local, because they have not existed long enough to admit of their wide dissemination; others, because circumstances in the animate or inanimate world have occurred to restrict the range which they may once have obtained. As a general rule, however, species, common to many distant provinces, or those now found to inhabit very distant parts of the globe, are to be regarded as the most ancient. Numerically speaking, they may not perhaps be largely represented, but their wide diffusion shows that they have had a long time to spread themselves, and have been able to survive many important revolutions in physical geography.

If my views are correct, it’s easy to explain why so many species are now limited to very narrow areas. Every local change, like those discussed in the previous chapter, tends to restrict the range of some species while expanding that of others. If we assume that new species emerge in just one place, each of them must take time to spread over a larger area. Therefore, if we accept this idea, the recent emergence of some species and the ancient existence of others both fit the overall fact of their limited distribution; some are local because they haven’t been around long enough to spread widely, while others are restricted due to changes in their environment or circumstances. Generally, though, species that are found in many distant regions or those currently located in far parts of the world should be considered the oldest. They might not be numerous, but their wide distribution indicates they’ve had a long time to spread and have survived significant changes in physical geography.

After so much evidence has been brought to light by the geologist, of land and sea having changed places in various regions since the existing species were in being, we can feel no surprise that the zoologist and botanist have hitherto found it difficult to refer the geographical distribution of species to any clear and determinate principles, since they have usually speculated on the phenomena, upon the assumption that the physical geography of the globe had undergone no material alteration since the introduction of the species now living. So long as this assumption was made, the facts relating to the geography of plants and animals appeared capricious in the extreme, and by many the subject was pronounced to be so full of mystery and anomalies, that the establishment of a satisfactory theory was hopeless.990

After so much evidence has been uncovered by geologists showing that land and sea have swapped places in various regions since current species came into existence, it's no surprise that zoologists and botanists have struggled to connect the geographical distribution of species to any clear and definite principles. They have often speculated about these phenomena based on the assumption that the Earth's physical geography hasn't changed significantly since these species were introduced. As long as this assumption held, the facts regarding the geography of plants and animals seemed extremely random, and many considered the topic so filled with mysteries and anomalies that developing a satisfactory theory felt impossible.990

Centres from which plants have been diffused.—Some botanists conceived, in accordance with the hypothesis of Wildenow, that mountains were the centres of creation from which the plants now inhabiting large continents have radiated; to which De Candolle and others, with much reason, objected, that mountains, on the contrary, are often the barriers between two provinces of distinct vegetation. The geologist who is acquainted with the extensive modifications which the surface of the 703 earth has undergone in very recent geological epochs, may be able, perhaps, to reconcile both these theories in their application to different regions.

Centers from which plants have spread.—Some botanists believed, following Wildenow's hypothesis, that mountains were the origins from which the plants now found across large continents have spread; however, De Candolle and others reasonably argued that mountains often act as barriers between two areas with different types of vegetation. A geologist familiar with the significant changes the Earth's surface has undergone in very recent geological periods might be able to reconcile both of these theories in relation to different regions.

A lofty range of mountains, which is so ancient as to date from a period when the species of animals and plants differed from those now living, will naturally form a barrier between contiguous provinces; but a chain which has been raised, in great part, within the epoch of existing species, and around which new lands have arisen from the sea within that period, will be a centre of peculiar vegetation.

A high mountain range that is so old it dates back to a time when animals and plants were different from those we have today will naturally act as a barrier between neighboring regions. However, a range that has mostly formed during the time of current species, and where new lands have emerged from the sea during that time, will have unique types of vegetation.

"In France," observes De Candolle, "the Alps and Cevennes prevent a great number of the plants of the south from spreading themselves to the northward; but it has been remarked that some species have made their way through the gorges of these chains, and are found on their northern sides, principally in those places where they are lower and more interrupted."991 Now the chains here alluded to have probably been of considerable height ever since the era when the existing vegetation began to appear, and were it not for the deep fissures which divide them, they might have caused much more abrupt terminations to the extension of distinct assemblages of species.

"In France," De Candolle notes, "the Alps and Cevennes block many southern plants from spreading north. However, it's been observed that some species have found their way through the gorges of these mountains and are located on their northern sides, especially in areas where they are lower and more fragmented." 991 The mountain ranges mentioned here have likely been quite tall since the time when the current vegetation started to develop, and if it weren't for the deep splits that separate them, they could have led to much more abrupt boundaries in the distribution of different groups of species.

Parts of the Italian peninsula, on the other hand, have gained a considerable portion of their present height since a majority of the marine species now inhabiting the Mediterranean, and probably, also, since the terrestrial plants of the same region were in being. Large tracts of land have been added, both on the Adriatic and Mediterranean side, to what originally constituted a much narrower range of mountains, if not a chain of islands running nearly north and south, like Corsica and Sardinia. It may therefore be presumed that the Apennines have been a centre whence species have diffused themselves over the contiguous lower and newer regions. In this and all analogous situations, the doctrine of Wildenow, that species have radiated from the mountains as from centres, may be well founded.

Parts of the Italian peninsula, on the other hand, have gained a significant amount of their current height since most of the marine species now living in the Mediterranean, and probably also since the land plants of the same region existed. Large areas of land have been added, both on the Adriatic and Mediterranean sides, to what originally formed a much narrower range of mountains, if not a chain of islands running almost north and south, like Corsica and Sardinia. It can therefore be assumed that the Apennines have been a center from which species have spread out into the nearby lower and newer regions. In this and all similar situations, the theory of Wildenow, that species have spread from the mountains as from centers, may be well founded.

Introduction of New Species.

If the reader should infer, from the facts laid before him in the preceding chapters, that the successive extinction of animals and plants may be part of the constant and regular course of nature, he will naturally inquire whether there are any means provided for the repair of these losses? Is it part of the economy of our system that the habitable globe should, to a certain extent, become depopulated both in the ocean and on the land; or that the variety of species should diminish until some new era arrives when a new and extraordinary effort of creative energy is to be displayed? Or is it possible that new species can be called into being from time to time, and yet that so astonishing a phenomenon can escape the observation of naturalists?

If the reader concludes, from the facts presented in the previous chapters, that the ongoing extinction of animals and plants may be a normal and regular part of nature, they will naturally wonder if there are ways to restore these losses. Is it part of our system's design that the habitable Earth should, to some extent, become less populated both in the ocean and on land, or that the variety of species should decrease until a new era emerges when exceptional creative energy is unleashed? Or is it possible for new species to arise periodically, yet such an incredible phenomenon goes unnoticed by naturalists?

704 Humboldt has characterized these subjects as among the mysteries which natural science cannot reach; and he observes that the investigation of the origin of beings does not belong to zoological or botanical geography. To geology, however, these topics do strictly appertain; and this science is chiefly interested in inquiries into the state of the animate creation as it now exists, with a view of pointing out its relations to antecedent periods when its condition was different.

704 Humboldt described these topics as some of the mysteries that natural science can't explore. He notes that studying the origins of living things doesn’t fall under zoological or botanical geography. However, these subjects do belong to geology, which is mainly focused on investigating the current state of living organisms and how they relate to earlier periods when their conditions were different.

Before offering any hypothesis towards the solution of so difficult a problem, let us consider what kind of evidence we ought to expect, in the present state of science, of the first appearance of new animals or plants, if we could imagine the successive creation of species to constitute, like their gradual extinction, a regular part of the economy of nature.

Before proposing any theories on such a challenging problem, let's think about what kind of evidence we should expect, given our current understanding of science, regarding the first emergence of new animals or plants, if we could envision the gradual creation of species as being, like their eventual extinction, a regular aspect of the natural order.

In the first place it is obviously more easy to prove that a species, once numerously represented in a given district, has ceased to be, than that some other which did not pre-exist has made its appearance—assuming always, for reasons before stated, that single stocks only of each animal and plant are originally created, and that individuals of new species do not suddenly start up in many different places at once.

In the first place, it is clearly easier to demonstrate that a species, once abundantly present in a certain area, is no longer found there than to show that a species that didn't previously exist has appeared—assuming, for the reasons stated earlier, that only single stocks of each animal and plant are originally created and that individuals of new species don’t suddenly emerge in many different locations at the same time.

So imperfect has the science of natural history remained down to our own times, that, within the memory of persons now living, the numbers of known animals and plants have been doubled, or even quadrupled, in many classes. New and often conspicuous species are annually discovered in parts of the old continent, long inhabited by the most civilized nations. Conscious, therefore, of the limited extent of our information, we always infer, when such discoveries are made, that the beings in question had previously eluded our research; or had at least existed elsewhere, and only migrated at a recent period into the territories where we now find them. It is difficult, even in contemplation, to anticipate the time when we shall be entitled to make any other hypothesis in regard to all the marine tribes, and to by far the greater number of the terrestrial;—such as birds, which possess such unlimited powers of migration; insects, which, besides the variability of each species in number, are also so capable of being diffused to vast distances; and cryptogamous plants, to which, as to many other classes, both of the animal and vegetable kingdom, similar observations are applicable.

The science of natural history has remained so imperfect that, within the memory of people alive today, the number of known animals and plants has doubled or even quadrupled in many categories. Each year, new and often striking species are discovered in parts of the old world, which have been inhabited by highly developed nations for a long time. Aware of the limited scope of our knowledge, we always conclude that when such discoveries happen, these creatures must have evaded our research before; or that they at least existed somewhere else and only recently migrated to the areas where we now find them. It’s hard to even think about the time when we might have to consider any other explanation regarding all marine species and the vast majority of land species—like birds, which can migrate extensively; insects, which not only vary greatly in their populations but can also spread over large distances; and types of plants that reproduce through spores, which share similar observations with many other classes in both the animal and plant kingdoms.

What kind of evidence of new creations could be expected?—What kind of proofs, therefore, could we reasonably expect to find of the origin at a particular period of a new species?

What kind of evidence of new creations could we expect?—What kind of proof, then, could we realistically expect to find regarding the origin of a new species at a specific time?

Perhaps it may be said in reply that, within the last two or three centuries, some forest tree or new quadruped might have been observed to appear suddenly in those parts, of England or France which had been most thoroughly investigated;—that naturalists might have been able to show that no such living being inhabited any other region of the globe, and that there was no tradition of anything similar having before been observed in the district where it had made its appearance.

Perhaps it can be said in response that, in the last two or three centuries, some forest tree or new mammal might have been seen suddenly appearing in those areas of England or France that had been most thoroughly explored;—that naturalists could have demonstrated that no such living being existed in any other part of the world, and that there was no record of anything like it being observed before in the area where it showed up.

Now, although this objection may seem plausible, yet its force will be found to depend entirely on the rate of fluctuation which we suppose to 705 prevail in the animate world, and on the proportion which such conspicuous subjects of the animal and vegetable kingdoms bear to those which are less known and escape our observation. There are, perhaps, more than a million species of plants and animals, exclusive of the microscopic and infusory animalcules, now inhabiting the terraqueous globe. The terrestrial plants may amount, says De Candolle, to somewhere between 110,000 and 120,000;992 but the data on which this conjecture is founded are considered by many botanists to be vague and unsatisfactory. Sprengel only enumerated, in 1827, about 31,000 known phænogamous, and 6000 cryptogamous plants; but that naturalist omitted many, perhaps 7000 phænogamous, and 1000 cryptogamous species. Mr. Lindley, in a letter to the author in 1836, expressed his opinion that it would be rash to speculate on the existence of more than 80,000 phænogamous, and 10,000 cryptogamous plants. "If we take," he says, in a letter to the author on this subject, "37,000 as the number of published phænogamous species, and then add, for the undiscovered species in Asia and New Holland, 15,000, in Africa 10,000, and in America 18,000, we have 80,000 species; and if 7000 be the number of published cryptogamous plants, and we allow 3000 for the undiscovered species (making 10,000), there would then be, on the whole, 90,000 species." But since that period one catalogue, as I learn from Dr. J. Hooker, contains a list of the names of 78,000 phænogamous plants which had been published before 1841.

Now, while this objection might seem reasonable, its strength really depends on the rate of change we assume prevails in the living world, and on the ratio of those noticeable species in the animal and plant kingdoms compared to those that are less known and go unnoticed. There are probably over a million species of plants and animals, not including microscopic organisms, currently living on Earth. The number of land plants may range, according to De Candolle, between 110,000 and 120,000; but many botanists consider the basis for this estimate to be unclear and unsatisfactory. In 1827, Sprengel only listed around 31,000 known flowering plants and 6,000 non-flowering plants; however, he missed many, possibly about 7,000 flowering and 1,000 non-flowering species. Mr. Lindley, in a letter to the author in 1836, stated that it would be unwise to guess there are more than 80,000 flowering plants and 10,000 non-flowering plants. "If we take," he mentions in a letter regarding this topic, "37,000 as the published number of flowering species, and then add 15,000 for undiscovered species in Asia and New Holland, 10,000 in Africa, and 18,000 in America, we arrive at 80,000 species; and if 7,000 is the number of known non-flowering plants, and we estimate 3,000 for undiscovered species (totaling 10,000), that would give us 90,000 species overall." However, since then, one catalog, according to Dr. J. Hooker, has a list of 78,000 flowering plants that were published before 1841.

It was supposed by Linnæus that there were four or five species of insects in the world for each phænogamous plant: but if we may judge from the relative proportion of the two classes in Great Britain, the number of insects must be still greater; for the total number of British insects, "according to the last census," is about 12,500;993 whereas there are only 1500 phænogamous plants indigenous to our island. As the insects are much more numerous in hot countries than in our temperate latitudes, it seems difficult to avoid the conclusion that there are more than half a million species in the world.

Linnæus believed there were four or five species of insects for every flowering plant in the world. However, judging by the number of both groups in Great Britain, there must be even more insects; the total count of British insects, "according to the last census," is around 12,500,993 while there are only 1,500 native flowering plants on our island. Since insects are much more abundant in warmer countries compared to our temperate regions, it seems hard to escape the conclusion that there are over half a million species globally.

The number of known mammifers, when Temminck wrote, exceeded 800, and Mr. Waterhouse informs me that more than 1200 are now (1850) ascertained to exist. Baron Cuvier estimated the amount of known fishes at 6000; and Mr. G. Gray, in his "Genera of Birds," enumerates 8000 species. We have still to add the reptiles, and all the invertebrated animals, exclusive of insects. It remains, in a great degree, mere matter of conjecture what proportion the aquatic tribes may bear to the denizens of the land; but the habitable surface beneath the waters can hardly be estimated at less than double that of the continents and islands, even admitting that a very considerable area is destitute of life, in consequence of great depth, cold, darkness, and other circumstances. In the late polar expedition it was found that, in some regions, as in Baffin's Bay, there were marine animals inhabiting the bottom at great depths, where the temperature of the water was below the freezing point. That there is 706 life at much greater profundities in warmer regions may be confidently inferred.

The number of known mammals, when Temminck wrote, was over 800, and Mr. Waterhouse tells me that more than 1200 are now confirmed to exist (1850). Baron Cuvier estimated the number of known fish at 6000, and Mr. G. Gray, in his "Genera of Birds," lists 8000 species. We still need to consider reptiles and all the invertebrates, excluding insects. It is still largely a guessing game what proportion the aquatic species might have compared to those on land; however, the habitable area beneath the waters is likely at least double that of the continents and islands, even though a significant area lacks life due to great depth, cold, darkness, and other factors. In the recent polar expedition, it was discovered that in some areas, like Baffin's Bay, marine animals were living on the ocean floor at great depths where the water temperature was below freezing. It's reasonable to conclude that life exists at even greater depths in warmer regions.

The ocean teems with life—the class of Polyps alone are conjectured by Lamarck to be as strong in individuals as insects. Every tropical reef is described as covered with Corals and Sponges, and swarming with Crustacea, Echini, and Testacea; while almost every tide-washed rock in the world is carpeted with Fuci, and supports some Corallines, Actiniæ, and Mollusca. There are innumerable forms in the seas of the warmer zones, which have scarcely begun to attract the attention of the naturalist; and there are parasitic animals without number, three or four of which are sometimes appropriated to one genus, as to the whale (Balæna), for example. Even though we concede, therefore, that the geographical range of marine species is more extensive in general than that of the terrestrial (the temperature of the sea being more uniform, and the land impeding less the migrations of the oceanic than the ocean those of the terrestrial species), yet it seems probable that the aquatic tribes far exceed in number the inhabitants of the land.

The ocean is full of life—the class of Polyps is believed by Lamarck to be as robust as insects in terms of individual strength. Every tropical reef is said to be covered with Corals and Sponges, teeming with Crustacea, Echini, and Testacea; while nearly every tide-swept rock around the world is blanketed with Fuci and supports various Corallines, Actiniæ, and Mollusca. There are countless forms in the seas of warmer regions that have barely begun to catch the interest of naturalists; and there are countless parasitic animals—three or four of which are sometimes grouped into one genus, such as with the whale (Balæna), for instance. Even if we agree that the geographical distribution of marine species is generally wider than that of terrestrial ones (because sea temperatures are more stable, and land less obstructs ocean species' migrations than vice versa), it still seems likely that aquatic species far outnumber those on land.

Without insisting on this point, it may be safe to assume, that, exclusive of microscopic beings, there are between one and two millions of species now inhabiting the terraqueous globe; so that if only one of these were to become extinct annually, and one new one were to be every year called into being, much more than a million of years might be required to bring about a complete revolution in organic life.

Without insisting on this point, it’s probably safe to assume that, aside from microscopic organisms, there are between one and two million species currently living on Earth; so that if just one of these species were to go extinct each year, and one new species were to come into existence every year, it could take well over a million years to achieve a complete shift in organic life.

I am not hazarding at present any hypothesis as to the probable rate of change; but none will deny that when the annual birth and the annual death of one species on the globe is proposed as a mere speculation, this at least is to imagine no slight degree of instability in the animate creation. If we divide the surface of the earth into twenty regions of equal area, one of these might comprehend a space of land and water about equal in dimensions to Europe, and might contain a twentieth part of the million of species which may be assumed to exist in the animal kingdom. In this region one species only would, according to the rate of mortality before assumed, perish in twenty years, or only five out of fifty thousand in the course of a century. But as a considerable proportion of the whole would belong to the aquatic classes, with which we have a very imperfect acquaintance, we must exclude them from our consideration; and if they constitute half of the entire number, then one species only might be lost in forty years among the terrestrial tribes. Now the Mammalia, whether terrestrial or aquatic, bear so small a proportion to other classes of animals, forming less, perhaps, than one thousandth part of the whole, that if the longevity of species in the different orders were equal, a vast period must elapse before it would come to the turn of this conspicuous class to lose one of their number. If one species only of the whole animal kingdom died out in forty years, no more than one mammifer might disappear in 40,000 years in a region of the dimensions of Europe.

I’m not making any guesses right now about how quickly things might change, but no one can deny that when we think about the annual birth and death of a species on Earth as just a thought experiment, we’re at least acknowledging a significant level of instability in living creatures. If we split the Earth's surface into twenty equal regions, one of these might cover a land and water area roughly the size of Europe and could hold one-twentieth of the million species that we assume exist in the animal kingdom. In this area, only one species would, based on the previously assumed mortality rate, go extinct in twenty years, or just five out of fifty thousand in a hundred years. However, since a large portion of the overall number would be aquatic species, which we don’t know much about, we should leave them out of the equation; if they make up half of all species, then only one species might be lost every forty years among the land animals. Now, mammals, whether land or water-based, are such a small fraction of other animal classes, probably making up less than one-thousandth of the total, that if the lifespan of species in different categories were the same, a long time would pass before this noticeable class would lose one of its members. If only one species of the entire animal kingdom went extinct in forty years, then only one mammal might vanish in 40,000 years in an area the size of Europe.

It is easy, therefore, to see, that in a small portion of such an area, in countries, for example, of the size of England and France, periods of 707 much greater duration must elapse before it would be possible to authenticate the first appearance of one of the larger plants and animals, assuming the annual birth and death of one species to be the rate of vicissitude in the animate creation throughout the world.

It’s clear, then, that in a small part of such a region, in countries like England and France, much longer periods of time would need to pass before we could confirm the first appearance of one of the larger plants and animals, if we consider the annual birth and death of a species as the rate of change in living organisms around the world.

The observations of naturalists upon living species may, in the course of future centuries, accumulate positive data, from which an insight into the laws which govern this part of our terrestrial system may be derived; but, in the present deficiency of historical records, we have traced up the subject to that point where geological monuments alone are capable of leading us on to the discovery of ulterior truths. To these, therefore, we must appeal, carefully examining the strata of recent formation wherein the remains of living species, both animal and vegetable, are known to occur. We must study these strata in strict reference to their chronological order, as deduced from their superposition, and other relations. From these sources we may learn which of the species, now our contemporaries, have survived the greatest revolutions of the earth's surface; which of them have co-existed with the greatest number of animals and plants now extinct; and which have made their appearance only when the animate world had nearly attained its present condition.

The observations of naturalists on living species may, over the course of future centuries, gather solid data, which could give us insights into the laws that govern this aspect of our planet's system; however, due to the current lack of historical records, we have traced the subject to a point where geological remains alone can guide us toward discovering further truths. Therefore, we must turn to these remains, carefully examining the layers of recent formations where the remains of living species, both animal and plant, are known to exist. We need to study these layers with strict attention to their chronological order, based on their placement and other relationships. From these sources, we can learn which species, now living alongside us, have survived the most significant changes to the earth's surface; which of them have coexisted with the most extinct animals and plants; and which emerged only when the living world had almost reached its current state.

From such data we may be enabled to infer, whether species have been called into existence in succession, or all at one period; whether singly, or by groups simultaneously; whether the antiquity of man be as high as that of any of the inferior beings which now share the planet with him, or whether the human species is one of the most recent of the whole.

From this data, we can determine whether species emerged one after another or all at once, whether they appeared individually or in groups at the same time, and whether humans have existed as long as any of the other species that currently inhabit the Earth, or if the human species is one of the most recent.

To some of these questions we can even now return a satisfactory answer; and with regard to the rest, we have some data to guide conjecture, and to enable us to speculate with advantage: but in order to be fully qualified to enter upon such discussions the reader must study the ample body of materials amassed by the industry of modern geologists.

To some of these questions, we can already provide a satisfactory answer; and for the others, we have some information to help us make educated guesses and speculate effectively. However, to be fully prepared to engage in these discussions, the reader needs to explore the extensive collection of materials gathered by the efforts of modern geologists.


CHAPTER XLIV.

EFFECTS PRODUCED BY THE POWERS OF VITALITY ON THE STATE OF THE EARTH'S SURFACE.

Modifications in physical geography caused by organic beings—Why the vegetable soil does not augment in thickness—The theory, that vegetation is an antagonist power counterbalancing the degradation caused by running water untenable—Conservative influence of vegetation—Rain diminished by felling of forests—Distribution of American forests dependent on direction of predominant winds—Influence of man in modifying the physical geography of the globe.

Modifications in physical geography caused by living organisms—Why the soil doesn’t get thicker—The idea that vegetation acts as a counterforce to the erosion caused by flowing water is not sustainable—The protective role of vegetation—Rainfall decreases when forests are cut down—The distribution of American forests is influenced by the direction of the main winds—The impact of humans on changing the physical geography of the planet.

The second branch of our inquiry, respecting changes of the organic world, relates to the processes by which the remains of animals and plants become fossil, or, to speak still more generally, to all the effects produced by the powers of vitality on the surface and shell of the earth.

The second part of our investigation, regarding changes in the organic world, focuses on the processes by which the remains of animals and plants turn into fossils, or more broadly, on all the effects that living forces have on the surface and structure of the Earth.

Before entering on the principal division of this subject, the imbedding and preservation of animal and vegetable remains, I shall offer a few remarks on the superficial modifications caused directly by the agency of organic beings, as when the growth of certain plants covers the slope of a mountain with peat, or converts a swamp into dry land; or when vegetation prevents the soil, in certain localities, from being washed away by running water.

Before diving into the main part of this topic, which is about the embedding and preservation of animal and plant remains, I want to share a few thoughts on the surface changes directly caused by organic beings. For example, when certain plants grow and cover a mountain slope with peat, or when they turn a swamp into dry land, or when vegetation stops soil in certain areas from being washed away by flowing water.

In considering alterations of this kind, brought about in the physical geography of particular tracts, we are too apt to think exclusively of that part of the earth's surface which has emerged from beneath the waters, and with which alone, as terrestrial beings, we are familiar. Here the direct power of animals and plants to cause any important variation is, of necessity, very limited, except in checking the progress of that decay of which the land is the chief theatre. But if we extend our views, and instead of contemplating the dry land, consider that larger portion which is assigned to the aquatic tribes, we discover the great influence of the living creation, in imparting varieties of conformation to the solid exterior which the agency of inanimate causes alone could not produce.

When we think about changes like these in the physical geography of specific areas, we often focus too much on the land that’s above water, which is the part of the earth we know best as land-dwelling beings. Here, the direct impact of animals and plants on significant changes is quite limited, mainly just in preventing the decay that happens on land. However, if we broaden our perspective and consider the much larger area that’s inhabited by aquatic life, we can see the substantial effect that living organisms have in shaping the physical features that wouldn't be created by inanimate forces alone.

Thus, when timber is floated into the sea, it is often drifted to vast distances, and subsides in spots where there might have been no deposit, at that time and place, if the earth had not been tenanted by living beings. If, therefore, in the course of ages, a hill of wood, or lignite, be thus formed in the subaqueous regions, a change in the submarine geography may be said to have resulted from the action of organic powers. So in regard to the growth of coral reefs; it is probable that a large 709 portion of the matter of which they are composed is supplied by mineral springs, which often rise up at the bottom of the sea, and which, on land, abound throughout volcanic regions hundreds of leagues in extent. The matter thus constantly given out could not go on accumulating for ever in the waters, but would be precipitated in the abysses of the sea, even if there were no polyps and testacea; but these animals arrest and secrete the carbonate of lime on the summits of submarine mountains, and form reefs many hundred feet in thickness, and hundreds of miles in length, where, but for them, none might ever have existed.

So, when wood is floated into the sea, it often drifts great distances and settles in places where there might not have been any accumulation if the earth hadn't been inhabited by living beings. Therefore, if over time a hill of wood or lignite is formed in underwater areas, we could say that a change in the underwater geography has occurred due to organic actions. The same applies to the growth of coral reefs; it's likely that a large 709 portion of the materials they consist of comes from mineral springs that often rise from the sea floor and are common on land in volcanic regions spanning hundreds of miles. The materials that are continuously released couldn't keep accumulating forever in the waters but would eventually settle in the depths of the sea, even without polyps and shellfish. However, these animals capture and secrete calcium carbonate on the tops of underwater mountains, creating reefs that are hundreds of feet thick and hundreds of miles long, where otherwise none might have existed.

Why the vegetable soil does not augment in thickness.—If no such voluminous masses are formed on the land, it is not from the want of solid matter in the structure of terrestrial animals and plants; but merely because, as I have so often stated, the continents are those parts of the globe where accessions of matter can scarcely ever take place—where, on the contrary, the most solid parts already formed are, each in their turn, exposed to gradual degradation. The quantity of timber and vegetable matter which grows in a tropical forest in the course of a century is enormous, and multitudes of animal skeletons are scattered there during the same period, besides innumerable land shells and other organic substances. The aggregate of these materials, therefore, might constitute a mass greater in volume than that which is produced in any coral-reef during the same lapse of years; but, although this process should continue on the land for ever, no mountains of wood or bone would be seen stretching far and wide over the country, or pushing out bold promontories into the sea. The whole solid mass is either devoured by animals, or decomposes, as does a portion of the rock and soil on which the animals and plants are supported.

Why the vegetable soil doesn’t thicken.—The reason there aren’t large accumulations of material on land isn’t due to a lack of solid matter from animals and plants; it’s simply because, as I’ve mentioned many times, continents are parts of the Earth where gaining new material is almost impossible—where, instead, the most solid parts are continually eroded. The amount of wood and plant matter produced in a tropical forest over a century is immense, and countless animal skeletons are scattered throughout that time, along with endless land shells and other organic materials. So, all these materials could form a mass larger in volume than what is produced in any coral reef over the same period; however, even if this process continued indefinitely on land, there wouldn’t be mountains of wood or bone spreading across the country or extending into the sea. The entire solid mass is either consumed by animals or breaks down, just like some of the rock and soil that support the animals and plants.

The waste of the strata themselves, accompanied by the decomposition of their organic remains, and the setting free of their alkaline ingredients, is one source from whence running water and the atmosphere may derive the materials which are absorbed by the roots and leaves of plants. Another source is the passage into a gaseous form of even the hardest parts of animals and plants which die and putrefy in the air, where they are soon resolved into the elements of which they are composed: and while a portion of these constituents is volatilized, the rest is taken up by rain-water, and sinks into the earth, or flows towards the sea; so that they enter again and again into the composition of different organic beings.

The waste from the layers themselves, along with the breakdown of their organic remains and the release of their alkaline components, is one source from which running water and the atmosphere can obtain the materials that are absorbed by the roots and leaves of plants. Another source comes from the conversion into gas of even the toughest parts of animals and plants that die and decay in the air, where they quickly break down into their elemental components: while some of these elements are vaporized, the rest gets absorbed by rainwater and seeps into the ground or flows toward the sea, allowing them to continuously re-enter the composition of various living organisms.

The principal elements found in plants are hydrogen, carbon, and oxygen; so that water and the atmosphere contain all of them, either in their own composition or in solution.994 The constant supply of these elements is maintained not only by the putrefaction of animal and vegetable substances, and the decay of rocks, but also by the copious evolution of carbonic acid and other gases from volcanoes and 710 mineral springs, and by the effects of ordinary evaporation, whereby aqueous vapors are made to rise from the ocean, and to circulate round the globe.

The main elements found in plants are hydrogen, carbon, and oxygen, which means that water and the atmosphere provide all of them, either in their own makeup or in solution.994 The continuous availability of these elements comes not just from the breakdown of animal and plant matter, and the erosion of rocks, but also from the large release of carbon dioxide and other gases from volcanoes and 710mineral springs, as well as from the normal process of evaporation, where water vapor rises from the ocean and circulates around the planet.

It is well known, that when two gases of different specific gravity are brought into contact, even though the heavier be the lowermost, they soon become uniformly diffused by mutual absorption through the whole space which they occupy. By virtue of this law, the heavy carbonic acid finds its way upwards through the lighter air of the atmosphere, and conveys nourishment to the lichen which covers the mountain top.

It is well known that when two gases with different densities come into contact, even if the heavier gas is at the bottom, they quickly mix evenly throughout the space they fill. Because of this principle, the heavy carbon dioxide rises through the lighter air in the atmosphere, providing nutrients to the lichen that grows on the mountaintop.

If the quantity of food consumed by terrestrial animals, and the elements imbibed by the roots and leaves of plants, were derived entirely from that supply of hydrogen, carbon, oxygen, nitrogen, and other elements, given out into the atmosphere and the waters by the putrescence of organic substances, then we might imagine that the vegetable mould would, after a series of years, neither gain nor lose a single particle by the action of organic beings; and this conclusion is not far from the truth; but the operation which renovates the vegetable and animal mould is by no means so simple as that here supposed. Thousands of carcases of terrestrial animals are floated down, every century, into the sea; and, together with forests of drift-timber, are imbedded in subaqueous deposits, where their elements are imprisoned in solid strata, and may there remain locked up throughout whole geological epochs before they again become subservient to the purposes of life.

If all the food eaten by land animals and the nutrients taken up by the roots and leaves of plants came solely from the hydrogen, carbon, oxygen, nitrogen, and other elements released into the atmosphere and water by the decay of organic materials, we could think that over many years, the soil would neither gain nor lose any particles because of the actions of living things. This idea isn’t too far from the truth, but the process that refreshes the soil for plants and animals is definitely more complex than that. Thousands of animal carcasses get washed into the ocean every century, and along with forests of driftwood, they become buried in submerged deposits, where their elements are trapped in solid layers and can stay locked away for entire geological periods before they are recycled back for life.

On the other hand, fresh supplies are derived by the atmosphere and by running water, as before stated, from the disintegration of rocks and their organic contents, and through the agency of mineral springs from the interior of the earth, from whence all the elements before mentioned, which enter principally into the composition of animals and vegetables, are continually evolved. Even nitrogen is found, by chemists, to be contained very generally in the waters of mineral springs.

On the other hand, new resources come from the atmosphere and flowing water, as mentioned earlier, from the breakdown of rocks and their organic materials, and through mineral springs from beneath the earth's surface, where all the elements previously mentioned, which are mainly involved in the formation of animals and plants, are consistently released. Even nitrogen is found by chemists to be commonly present in the waters of mineral springs.

Vegetation not an antagonist power counterbalancing the action of running water.—If we suppose that the copious supply from the nether regions, by springs and volcanic vents, of carbonic acid and other gases, together with the decomposition of rocks, may be just sufficient to counterbalance that loss of matter which, having already served for the nourishment of animals and plants, is annually carried down in organized forms, and buried in subaqueous strata, we concede the utmost that is consistent with probability. An opinion, however, has been expressed, that the processes of vegetable life, by absorbing various gases from the atmosphere, cause so large a mass of solid matter to accumulate on the surface of the land, that this mass alone may constitute a great counterpoise to all the matter transported to lower levels by the aqueous agents of decay. "Torrents and rivers," it is said—"the waves of the sea and marine currents—act upon lines only; but the power of vegetation to absorb the elastic and non-elastic fluids circulating round the earth, extends over the whole surface of the continents. By the silent but universal action of this great antagonist power, the spoliation and 711 waste caused by running water on the land, and by the movements of the ocean, are neutralized, and even counterbalanced."995

Vegetation is not a rival force counteracting the flow of running water.—If we assume that the abundant supply from underground sources, through springs and volcanic vents, of carbon dioxide and other gases, along with the breakdown of rocks, is enough to offset the loss of material that has already nourished animals and plants and is annually washed away in organic forms to be buried in underwater layers, we are acknowledging the maximum that is plausible. However, there is a belief that the processes of plant life, by absorbing various gases from the atmosphere, lead to such a large accumulation of solid matter on land that this alone may significantly balance out all the material carried to lower levels by the natural processes of decay. "Streams and rivers," it’s said—"the waves of the sea and ocean currents—affect only specific paths; but the ability of plants to absorb both gaseous and non-gaseous substances flowing around the planet covers the entire surface of the continents. Through the quiet yet widespread influence of this powerful counterforce, the erosion and loss caused by running water on land and by ocean movements are neutralized and even balanced out."995

In opposition to these views, I conceive that we shall form a juster estimate of the influence of vegetation, if we consider it as being in a slight degree conservative, and capable of retarding the waste of land, but not of acting as an antagonist power. The vegetable mould is seldom more than a few feet in thickness, and frequently does not exceed a few inches; and we by no means find that its volume is more considerable on those parts of our continents which we can prove, by geological data, to have been elevated at more ancient periods, and where, consequently, there has been the greatest time for the accumulation of vegetable matter, produced throughout successive zoological epochs. On the contrary, these higher and older regions are more frequently denuded, so as to expose the bare rock to the action of the sun and air.

In contrast to these opinions, I believe we can have a better understanding of the impact of vegetation if we see it as somewhat conservative and capable of slowing down land degradation, but not as a competing force. The layer of soil is rarely more than a few feet thick and often just a few inches. We also don’t find that its volume is larger in those areas of our continents that geological data shows have been uplifted for much longer periods, where there has been more time for plant material to accumulate over different eras. On the contrary, these higher and older regions are often stripped bare, exposing the solid rock to sunlight and air.

We find in the torrid zone, where the growth of plants is most rank and luxurious, that accessions of matter due to their agency are by no means the most conspicuous. Indeed it is in these latitudes, where the vegetation is most active, that, for reasons to be explained in the next chapter, even those superficial peat mosses are unknown which cover a large area in some parts of our temperate zone. If the operation of animal and vegetable life could restore to the general surface of the continents a portion of the elements of those disintegrated rocks of which such enormous masses are swept down annually into the sea, the effects would long ere this have constituted one of the most striking features in the structure and composition of our continents. All the great steppes and table-lands of the world, where the action of running water is feeble, would have become the grand repositories of organic matter, accumulated without that intermixture of earthy sediment which so generally characterizes the subaqueous strata.

In the hot zone, where plant growth is most abundant and lush, the contributions of matter from this growth are not the most noticeable. In fact, it's in these areas with the most active vegetation that, for reasons explained in the next chapter, even the superficial peat mosses are absent, despite covering large areas in some regions of the temperate zone. If the processes of animal and plant life could return some of the elements from the disintegrated rocks that are washed into the sea each year back to the surface of the continents, the impact would have already become one of the most significant aspects of the structure and composition of our continents. All the major steppes and plateaus around the world, where the flow of running water is weak, would have turned into vast deposits of organic matter, built up without the mix of earthy sediment that typically characterizes underwater layers.

I have already stated that, in the known operation of the igneous causes, a real antagonist power is found, which may counterbalance the levelling action of running water (p. 563); and there seems no good reason for presuming that the upheaving and depressing force of earthquakes, together with the ejection of matter by volcanoes, may not be fully adequate to restore that inequality of the surface which rivers and the waves and currents of the ocean annually tend to lessen. If a counterpoise be derived from this source, the quantity and elevation of land above the sea may for ever remain the same, in spite of the action of the aqueous causes, which, if thus counteracted, may never be able to reduce the surface of the earth more nearly to a state of equilibrium than that which it has now attained; and, on the other hand, the force of the aqueous agents themselves might thus continue for ever unimpaired.

I have already mentioned that, in the known operation of the igneous causes, there is a real opposing force that can balance the leveling effect of flowing water (p. 563); and there seems to be no good reason to assume that the uplifting and sinking force of earthquakes, along with the release of material from volcanoes, might not be enough to restore the unevenness of the surface that rivers and the ocean's waves and currents tend to reduce each year. If this source provides a counterbalance, the amount and height of land above sea level could remain constant, despite the effects of water, which, if countered in this way, may never be able to bring the earth's surface closer to a state of balance than it currently is; and on the other hand, the effectiveness of the water agents themselves could also remain undiminished forever.

Conservative influence of vegetation.—If, then, vegetation cannot act as an antagonist power amid the mighty agents of change which are always modifying the surface of the globe, let us next inquire how far 712 its influence is conservative,—how far it may retard the levelling effects of running water, which it cannot oppose, much less counterbalance.

Conservative influence of vegetation.—If vegetation can't act as a counterforce against the powerful forces of change that are constantly altering the Earth's surface, let's next explore how much its influence is conservative—how much it can slow down the leveling effects of flowing water, which it can't resist, let alone counteract.

It is well known that a covering of herbage and shrubs may protect a loose soil from being carried away by rain, or even by the ordinary action of a river, and may prevent hills of loose sand from being blown away by the wind; for the roots bind together the separate particles into a firm mass, and the leaves intercept the rain-water, so that it dries up gradually, instead of flowing off in a mass and with great velocity. The old Italian hydrographers make frequent mention of the increased degradation which has followed the clearing away of natural woods in several parts of Italy. A remarkable example was afforded in the Upper Val d' Arno, in Tuscany, on the removal of the woods clothing the steep declivities of the hills by which that valley is bounded. When the ancient forest laws were abolished by the Grand Duke Joseph, during the last century, a considerable tract of surface in the Cassentina (the Clausentinium of the Romans) was denuded, and immediately the quantity of sand and soil washed down into the Arno increased enormously. Frisi, alluding to such occurrences, observes, that as soon as the bushes and plants were removed, the waters flowed off more rapidly, and, in the manner of floods, swept away the vegetable soil.996

It’s well known that a layer of grass and shrubs can protect loose soil from being washed away by rain or even by the normal flow of a river, and can stop hills of loose sand from being blown away by the wind. The roots hold the individual particles together into a solid mass, and the leaves catch the rainwater, allowing it to slowly soak in instead of rushing off in a flood. The old Italian hydrologists often talked about the increased erosion that followed the removal of natural forests in various parts of Italy. A notable example is found in the Upper Val d'Arno in Tuscany, where the removal of the woods covering the steep hills surrounding the valley took place. When the ancient forest laws were lifted by Grand Duke Joseph in the last century, a significant area of land in Cassentina (the Clausentinium of the Romans) was stripped bare, and immediately the amount of sand and soil washed into the Arno increased dramatically. Frisi noted that once the bushes and plants were taken away, the water flowed off more quickly and, like a flood, carried away the topsoil.996

This effect of vegetation is of high interest to the geologist, when he is considering the formation of those valleys which have been principally due to the action of rivers. The spaces intervening between valleys, whether they be flat or ridgy, when covered with vegetation, may scarcely undergo the slightest waste, as the surface may be protected by the green sward of grass; and this may be renewed, in the manner before described, from elements derived from rain-water and the atmosphere. Hence, while the river is continually bearing down matter in the alluvial plain, and undermining the cliffs on each side of every valley, the height of the intervening rising grounds may remain stationary.

This effect of vegetation really interests geologists when they're looking at how rivers shape valleys. The areas between valleys, whether flat or hilly, can hardly wear away when they're covered in plants, as the grass provides protection for the surface. This grass can be replenished, as mentioned earlier, using nutrients from rainwater and the atmosphere. So while the river constantly washes away material in the floodplain and erodes the cliffs on either side of each valley, the height of the land in between can stay the same.

In this manner, a cone of loose scoriæ, sand, and ashes, such as Monte Nuovo, may, when it has once become densely clothed with herbage and shrubs, suffer scarcely any further dilapidation; and the perfect state of the cones of hundreds of extinct volcanoes in France, the Neapolitan territory, Sicily, and elsewhere, may prove nothing whatever, either as to their relative or absolute antiquity. We may be enabled to infer, from the integrity of such conical hills of incoherent materials, that no flood can have passed over the countries where they are situated, since their formation; but the atmospheric action alone, in spots where there happen to be no torrents, and where the surface was clothed with vegetation, could scarcely in any lapse of ages have destroyed them.

In this way, a cone of loose scoria, sand, and ash, like Monte Nuovo, can, once it becomes covered with grass and shrubs, experience hardly any further wear and tear; and the well-preserved cones of many extinct volcanoes in France, Naples, Sicily, and other places may not indicate anything about their relative or absolute age at all. We can infer from the stability of these conical hills made of loose materials that no flood has swept through the areas where they are found since they were formed; rather, only atmospheric conditions, in places without streams and where the ground was covered in vegetation, could hardly have eroded them over many ages.

During a tour in Spain, in 1830, I was surprised to see a district of gently undulating ground in Catalonia, consisting of red and gray sandstone, and in some parts of red marl, almost entirely denuded of herbage; while the roots of the pines, holm oaks, and some other trees, were half 713 exposed, as if the soil had been washed away by a flood. Such is the state of the forests, for example, between Oristo and Vich, and near San Lorenzo. But, being overtaken by a violent thunder-storm, in the month of August, I saw the whole surface, even the highest levels of some flat-topped hills, streaming with mud, while on every declivity the devastation of torrents was terrific. The peculiarities in the physiognomy of the district were at once explained; and I was taught that, in speculating on the greater effects which the direct action of rain may once have produced on the surface of certain parts of England, we need not revert to periods when the heat of the climate was tropical.

During a trip to Spain in 1830, I was amazed to see a region of gently rolling land in Catalonia, made up of red and gray sandstone, and in some areas, red marl, almost completely stripped of vegetation; the roots of the pines, holm oaks, and some other trees were partially exposed, as if the soil had been washed away by a flood. This was the condition of the forests, for example, between Oristo and Vich, and near San Lorenzo. However, when a fierce thunderstorm hit in August, I saw the entire landscape, even the highest points of some flat-topped hills, flowing with mud, while the destruction from the torrents on every slope was shocking. The unique features of the area became clear; I learned that when considering the significant impact that rainfall may have had on the surface of certain parts of England, we don't need to think back to times when the climate was tropical.

In the torrid zone the degradation of land is generally more rapid; but the waste is by no means proportioned to the superior quantity of rain or the suddenness of its fall, the transporting power of water being counteracted by a greater luxuriance of vegetation. A geologist who is no stranger to tropical countries observes, that the softer rocks would speedily be washed away in such regions, if the numerous roots of plants were not matted together in such a manner as to produce considerable resistance to the destructive power of the rains. The parasitical and creeping plants also entwine in every possible direction, so as to render the forests nearly impervious, and the trees possess forms and leaves best calculated to shoot off the heavy rains; which, when they have thus been broken in their fall, are quickly absorbed by the ground beneath, or, when thrown into the drainage depressions, give rise to furious torrents.997

In the hot zone, land degradation usually happens more quickly; however, the damage isn’t directly related to the higher amount of rain or how suddenly it falls, since the ability of water to carry away soil is balanced by more abundant plant life. A geologist familiar with tropical regions notes that softer rocks would erode rapidly in these areas if it weren't for the many roots of plants that intertwine to provide significant resistance against the damaging effects of rain. Parasites and creeping plants also wrap around each other in every possible way, making the forests nearly impenetrable, and the trees have shapes and leaves that effectively deflect heavy rainfall, which, when softened during their descent, is quickly absorbed by the ground or channeled into low areas, creating intense torrents.997

Influence of Man in modifying the Physical Geography of the Globe.

Before concluding this chapter, I shall offer a few observations on the influence of man in modifying the physical geography of the globe; for we must class his agency among the powers of organic nature.

Before concluding this chapter, I want to share a few thoughts on how humans impact the physical geography of the Earth, as we need to consider their role as part of the forces of organic nature.

Felling of forests.—The felling of forests has been attended, in many countries, by a diminution of rain, as in Barbadoes and Jamaica.998 For in tropical countries, where the quantity of aqueous vapor in the atmosphere is great, but where, on the other hand, the direct rays of the sun are most powerful, any impediment to the free circulation of air, or any screen which shades the earth from the solar rays, becomes a source of humidity; and wherever dampness and cold have begun to be generated by such causes, the condensation of vapor continues. The leaves, moreover, of all plants are alembics, and some of those in the torrid zone have the remarkable property of distilling water, thus contributing to prevent the earth from becoming parched up.

Cutting Down Forests.—Cutting down forests in many countries has led to less rainfall, as seen in Barbados and Jamaica.998 In tropical regions, where there's a lot of water vapor in the air and the sun's rays are intense, any barrier to the free flow of air or any shade cast on the ground from sunlight creates humidity. Wherever dampness and cold start to develop because of these factors, the condensation of vapor continues. Additionally, the leaves of all plants act like distillation devices, and some plants in the tropics have the unique ability to produce water, helping to prevent the ground from drying out.

Distribution of the American forests.—There can be no doubt then, that the state of the climate, especially the humidity of the atmosphere, influences vegetation, and that, in its turn, vegetation re-acts upon the 714 climate: but some writers seem to have attributed too much importance to the influence of forests, particularly those of America, as if they were the primary cause of the moisture of the climate.

Distribution of the American forests.—There’s no doubt that the climate, especially the humidity in the air, affects plant life, and that plant life also impacts the climate: however, some authors appear to overstate the role of forests, especially those in America, as if they were the main reason for the moisture in the climate.

The theory of a modern author on this subject "that forests exist in those parts of America only where the predominant winds carry with them a considerable quantity of moisture from the ocean," seems far more rational. In all countries, he says, "having a summer heat exceeding 70°, the presence or absence of natural woods, and their greater or less luxuriance, may be taken as a measure of the amount of humidity, and of the fertility of the soil. Short and heavy rains in a warm country will produce grass, which, having its roots near to the surface, springs up in a few days, and withers when the moisture is exhausted; but transitory rains, however heavy, will not nourish trees; because, after the surface is saturated, the remainder of the water runs off, and the moisture lodged in the soil neither sinks deep enough, nor is in sufficient quantity, to furnish the giants of the forests with the necessary sustenance. It may be assumed that twenty inches of rain falling moderately or at intervals, will leave a greater permanent supply in the soil than forty inches falling, as it sometimes does in the torrid zone, in as many hours."999

The modern author’s theory on this topic—that forests only grow in areas of America where the dominant winds bring in a significant amount of moisture from the ocean—makes a lot more sense. He states that in any country where summer temperatures exceed 70°F, you can gauge the amount of humidity and soil fertility by the presence or absence of natural woods and how lush they are. In warm countries, brief and heavy rains can produce grass that quickly sprouts from shallow roots but withers once the moisture is gone. However, temporary heavy rains won't support trees because once the surface is saturated, excess water runs off, and the moisture in the soil isn't deep enough or abundant enough to provide for the towering trees. It's reasonable to think that twenty inches of rain spread out over time will leave a more lasting supply in the soil compared to forty inches falling all at once, as can happen in tropical regions, over just a few hours.999

"In all regions," he continues, "where ranges of mountains intercept the course of the constant or predominant winds, the country on the windward side of the mountains will be moist, and that on the leeward dry; and hence parched deserts will generally be found on the west side of countries within the tropics, and on the east side of those beyond them, the prevailing winds in these cases being generally in opposite directions. On this principle, the position of forests in North and South America may be explained. Thus, for example, in the region within the thirtieth parallel, the moisture swept up by the trade-wind from the Atlantic is precipitated in part upon the mountains of Brazil, which are but low, and so distributed as to extend far into the interior. The portion which remains is borne westward, and, losing a little as it proceeds, is at length arrested by the Andes, where it falls down in showers on their summits. The aërial current, now deprived of all the humidity with which it can part, arrives in a state of complete exsiccation at Peru, where consequently no rain falls. But in the region of America, beyond the thirtieth parallel, the Andes serve as a screen to intercept the moisture brought by the prevailing winds from the Pacific Ocean: rains are copious on their summits, and in Chili on their western declivities; but none falls on the plains to the eastward, except occasionally when the wind blows from the Atlantic."1000

"In all areas," he continues, "where mountain ranges block the path of the steady or predominant winds, the land facing the winds will be moist, while the side sheltered from the winds will be dry; as a result, dry deserts are usually found on the west side of countries within the tropics and on the east side of those beyond them, the prevailing winds in these cases generally blowing in opposite directions. This principle helps explain the location of forests in North and South America. For instance, in the region around the thirtieth parallel, the moisture carried by the trade winds from the Atlantic is partially released as rain on the low mountains of Brazil, which are distributed in a way that extends far into the interior. The moisture that remains is pushed westward, losing some along the way, and is ultimately stopped by the Andes, where it falls as rain on their peaks. The air current, now completely dry, arrives in Peru, where hardly any rain falls. However, in the area of America beyond the thirtieth parallel, the Andes act as a barrier to capture the moisture brought by the prevailing winds from the Pacific Ocean: there's plenty of rain on their peaks and in Chile on their western slopes; but little falls on the plains to the east, except occasionally when the wind comes from the Atlantic."1000

I have been more particular in explaining these views, because they appear to place in a true light the dependence of vegetation on climate, the humidity being increased, and more uniformly diffused throughout the year, by the gradual spreading of wood.

I have been more specific in explaining these ideas because they seem to clearly show how vegetation relies on climate, with humidity increasing and becoming more evenly distributed throughout the year due to the gradual spread of forest.

715 It has been affirmed, that formerly, when France and England were covered with wood, Europe was much colder than at present; that the winters in Italy were longer, and that the Seine, and many other rivers, froze more regularly every winter than now. M. Arago, in an essay on this subject, has endeavored to show, by tables of observations on the congelation of the Rhine, Danube, Rhone, Po, Seine, and other rivers, at different periods, that there is no reason to believe the cold to have been in general more intense in ancient times.1001 He admits, however, that the climate of Tuscany has been so far modified, by the removal of wood, as that the winters are less cold; but the summers also, he contends, are less hot than of old; and the summers, according to him, were formerly hotter in France than in our own times. His evidence is derived chiefly from documents showing that wine was made three centuries ago in the Vivarais and several other provinces, at an earlier season, at greater elevations, and in higher latitudes, than are now found suitable to the vine.

715 It has been confirmed that in the past, when France and England were heavily forested, Europe was much colder than it is today; winters in Italy were longer, and the Seine, along with many other rivers, froze more consistently every winter than they do now. M. Arago, in an essay on this topic, has attempted to demonstrate, through observation tables of the freezing of the Rhine, Danube, Rhone, Po, Seine, and other rivers at various times, that there’s no reason to think the cold was generally more intense in ancient times.1001 He does acknowledge, however, that the climate of Tuscany has changed to some degree due to deforestation, resulting in milder winters; but he argues that summers are also less hot than in the past. According to him, summers were previously hotter in France than they are now. His evidence mainly comes from documents indicating that wine was produced three centuries ago in the Vivarais and several other provinces at an earlier time, at higher elevations, and in northern latitudes that are no longer considered suitable for grapevines.

There seems little doubt that in the United States of North America the rapid clearing of the country has rendered the winters less severe and the summers less hot; in other words, the extreme temperatures of January and July have been observed from year to year to approach somewhat nearer to each other. Whether in this case, or in France, the mean temperature has been raised, seems by no means as yet decided; but there is no doubt that the climate has become, as Buffon would have said, "less excessive."

There’s no doubt that in the United States, the quick development of the country has made winters milder and summers cooler. In other words, the extreme temperatures in January and July have been getting closer together over the years. It's still uncertain whether the average temperature has increased in this case or in France, but it’s clear that the climate has become, as Buffon would have put it, "less extreme."

I have before shown, when treating of the excavation of new estuaries in Holland by inroads of the ocean, as also of the changes on our own coasts, that although the conversion of sea into land by artificial labors may be great, yet it must always be in subordination to the power of the tides and currents, or to the great movements which alter the relative level of the land and sea, (Chap. XX.) If, in addition to the assistance obtained by parliamentary grants for defending Dunwich from the waves, all the resources of Europe had been directed to the same end, the existence of that port might perhaps have been prolonged for several centuries (p. 310.) But in the mean time, the current would have continued to sweep away portions from the adjoining cliffs on each side, giving to the whole line of coast its present form, until at length the town, projecting as a narrow promontory, must have become exposed to the irresistible fury of the waves.

I have previously shown, when discussing the creation of new estuaries in Holland due to ocean inroads, as well as the changes along our own coasts, that while the transformation of sea into land through human efforts can be significant, it will always be subject to the power of tides and currents, or to the major movements that change the relative levels of land and sea, (Chap. XX.) Even if all of Europe’s resources, along with parliamentary grants, had been dedicated to protecting Dunwich from the waves, the survival of that port might have only been extended for a few centuries (p. 310.) Meanwhile, the current would have continued to erode parts of the nearby cliffs on either side, shaping the entire coastline into its current form, until eventually, the town, sticking out like a narrow promontory, would have been left vulnerable to the overwhelming force of the waves.

It is scarcely necessary to observe, that the control which man can obtain over the igneous agents is less even than that which he may exert over the aqueous. He cannot modify the upheaving or depressing force of earthquakes, or the periods or degree of violence of volcanic eruptions; and on these causes the inequalities of the earth's surface, and, consequently, the shape of the sea and land, appear mainly to depend. The utmost that man can hope to effect in this respect is occasionally to divert the course of a lava-stream, and to prevent the burning matter, for 716 a season, from overwhelming a city, or some other of the proudest works of human industry.

It’s hardly necessary to point out that the control humans have over volcanic forces is even less than what they have over water. We can’t change the force of earthquakes or the timing and intensity of volcanic eruptions; these factors largely determine the unevenness of the earth’s surface, which shapes both sea and land. The most we can hope to do is occasionally redirect a lava flow and keep the molten material from burying a city or some of our greatest human achievements for a little while. 716

If all the nations of the earth should attempt to quarry away the lava which flowed during one eruption from the Icelandic volcanoes in 1783, and the two following years, and should attempt to consign it to the deepest abysses of the ocean, they might toil for thousands of years and not accomplish their task. Yet the matter borne down to the sea by two great rivers, the Ganges and Burrampooter, in each quarter of a century, probably equals in weight and volume the mass of Icelandic lava produced by that great eruption (p. 282). So insignificant is the aggregate force exerted by man, when contrasted with the ordinary operations of aqueous or igneous agents in the natural world.

If all the countries in the world tried to remove the lava that flowed from the Icelandic volcanoes in 1783 and the following two years, and then dumped it into the deepest parts of the ocean, they could work for thousands of years and still not finish the job. Yet, the amount of material carried to the sea by two major rivers, the Ganges and Burrampooter, every quarter-century likely matches the weight and volume of the Icelandic lava produced by that massive eruption (p. 282). This highlights how minimal the total impact of humanity is when compared to the natural forces of water and fire in the world.

No application, perhaps, of human skill and labor tends so greatly to vary the state of the habitable surface, as that employed in the drainage of lakes and marshes, since not only the stations of many animals and plants, but the general climate of a district, may thus be modified. It is also a kind of alteration to which it is difficult to find anything analogous in the agency of inferior beings; for we ought always, before we decide that any part of the influence of man is novel and anomalous, carefully to consider the powers of all other animated agents which may be limited or superseded by him.1002 Many who have reasoned on these subjects seem to have forgotten that the human race often succeeds to the discharge of functions previously fulfilled by other species. Suppose the growth of some of the larger terrestrial plants, or, in other words, the extent of forest, to be diminished by man, and the climate to be thereby modified, it does not follow that this kind of innovation is unprecedented. It is a change in the state of vegetation, and such may often have been the result of the appearance of new species upon the earth. The multiplication, for example, of certain insects in parts of Germany, during the last century, destroyed more trees than man, perhaps, could have felled during an equal period.

No application of human skill and labor changes the condition of the land more than draining lakes and marshes, as it can alter not just the habitats of various animals and plants but also the overall climate of an area. It's also a type of change that's hard to find a parallel for in the actions of lesser beings; we ought to think carefully about the abilities of all other living agents that might be limited or replaced by humans before deciding that any of human influence is new and unusual. Many who have explored these topics seem to have overlooked that humanity often takes over roles once filled by other species. For instance, if humans reduce the growth of larger terrestrial plants, or in other words, decrease forest cover, and this modifies the climate, it doesn't mean this change is unprecedented. It alters the state of vegetation, and such changes may have often occurred with the introduction of new species on Earth. The increase in certain insects in parts of Germany during the last century, for example, destroyed more trees than humans might have cut down in the same timeframe.

It would be rash, however, to affirm that the power of man to modify the surface may not differ in kind or degree from that of other living beings; although the problem is certainly more complex than many who have speculated on such topics have imagined. If land be raised from the sea, the greatest alteration in its physical condition, which could ever arise from the influence of organic beings, would probably be produced by the first immigration of terrestrial plants, whereby the new tract would become covered with vegetation. The change next in importance would seem to be when animals first enter, and modify the proportionate numbers of certain species of plants. If there be any anomaly in the intervention of man, in farther varying the relative 717 numbers in the vegetable kingdom, it may not so much consist in the kind or absolute quantity of alteration, as in the circumstance that a single species, in this case, would exert, by its superior power and universal distribution, an influence equal to that of hundreds of other terrestrial animals.

It would be reckless, however, to claim that humans' ability to change the environment is fundamentally different from that of other living beings; although the issue is definitely more complicated than many who have thought about these topics realize. If land is lifted from the sea, the biggest change in its physical condition, which could ever result from the influence of living organisms, would likely be caused by the first arrival of land plants, which would cover the new area with vegetation. The next most significant change seems to happen when animals first arrive and alter the relative numbers of certain plant species. If there is anything unusual about the role of humans in further changing the relative 717 numbers in the plant kingdom, it might not be so much about the type or total amount of change, but rather in the fact that a single species, in this case, would have, because of its greater power and widespread presence, an impact equal to that of hundreds of other land animals.

If we inquire whether man, by his direct power, or by the changes which he may give rise to indirectly, tends, upon the whole, to lessen or increase the inequalities of the earth's surface, we shall incline, perhaps, to the opinion that he is a levelling agent. In mining operations he conveys upwards a certain quantity of materials from the bowels of the earth; but, on the other hand, much rock is taken annually from the land, in the shape of ballast, and afterwards thrown into the sea, and by this means, in spite of prohibitory laws, many harbors, in various parts of the world, have been blocked up. We rarely transport heavy materials to higher levels, and our pyramids and cities are chiefly constructed of stone brought down from more elevated situations. By ploughing up thousands of square miles, and exposing a surface for part of the year to the action of the elements, we assist the abrading force of rain, and diminish the conservative effects of vegetation.

If we ask whether humans, through their direct actions or the indirect changes they cause, tend to lessen or increase the inequalities of the earth's surface, we might lean towards the view that they are equalizing forces. In mining, they bring a certain amount of materials up from deep within the earth; however, a lot of rock is also removed from the land each year as ballast and then dumped into the sea, which has, despite laws against it, blocked many harbors around the world. We rarely transport heavy materials to higher places, and our pyramids and cities are mostly built from stone that has been brought down from higher locations. By plowing thousands of square miles and exposing the soil for part of the year to the elements, we aid the erosive forces of rain and reduce the protective effects of vegetation.


CHAPTER XLV.

INCLOSING OF FOSSILS IN PEAT, BROWN SAND, AND VOLCANIC EJECTIONS.

Division of the subject—Imbedding of organic remains in deposits on emerged land—Growth of peat—Site of ancient forests in Europe now occupied by peat—Bog iron-ore—Preservation of animal substances in peat—Miring of quadrupeds—Bursting of the Solway moss—Great Dismal Swamp—Imbedding of organic bodies and human remains in blown sand—Moving sands of African deserts—De Luc on their recent origin—Buried temple of Ipsambul—Dried carcases in the sands—Towns overwhelmed by sand-floods—Imbedding of organic and other remains in volcanic formations on the land.

Division of the subject—Embedding of organic remains in deposits on land that has emerged—Formation of peat—Location of ancient forests in Europe now covered by peat—Bog iron ore—Preservation of animal materials in peat—Trapping of mammals—Bursting of the Solway moss—Great Dismal Swamp—Embedding of organic bodies and human remains in blown sand—Shifting sands of African deserts—De Luc on their recent origins—Buried temple of Ipsambul—Dried carcasses in the sands—Towns buried by sand floods—Embedding of organic and other remains in volcanic formations on land.

Division of the subject.—The next subject of inquiry is the mode in which the remains of animals and plants become fossil, or are buried in the earth by natural causes. M. Constant Prevost has observed, that the effects of geological causes are divisible into two great classes; those produced during the submersion of land beneath the waters, and those which take place after its emersion. Agreeably to this classification, I shall consider, first, in what manner animal and vegetable remains become included and preserved in deposits on emerged land, or that part of the surface which is not permanently covered by water, whether of seas or lakes; secondly, the manner in which organic remains become imbedded in subaqueous deposits.

Division of the subject.—The next topic of exploration is how the remains of animals and plants turn into fossils or are buried in the earth by natural processes. M. Constant Prevost has noted that the effects of geological processes can be divided into two main categories: those that occur when land is submerged under water, and those that occur after it is raised above water. Following this categorization, I will first examine how animal and plant remains are included and preserved in deposits on land that is not permanently covered by water, whether from seas or lakes; secondly, I will look at how organic remains become embedded in underwater deposits.

Under the first division, I shall treat of the following topics:—1st, the growth of peat, and the preservation of vegetable and animal remains therein;—2dly, the burying of organic remains in blown sand;—3dly, of the same in the ejections and alluviums of volcanoes;—4thly, in alluviums generally, and in the ruins of landslips;—5thly, in the mud and stalagmite of caves and fissures.

Under the first section, I will discuss the following topics: 1st, the formation of peat and the preservation of plant and animal remains in it; 2nd, the burial of organic remains in windblown sand; 3rd, the same in the deposits and sediments from volcanoes; 4th, in alluvial deposits in general and in the remnants of landslips; 5th, in the mud and stalagmites found in caves and fissures.

Growth of Peat, and Preservation of Vegetable and Animal Remains therein.

The generation of peat, when not completely under water, is confined to moist situations, where the temperature is low, and where vegetables may decompose without putrefying. It may consist of any of the numerous plants which are capable of growing in such stations; but a species of moss (Sphagnum) constitutes a considerable part of the peat found in marshes of the north of Europe; this plant having the property of throwing up new shoots in its upper part, while its lower extremities are decaying.1003 Reeds, rushes, and other aquatic plants may usually be traced in peat; and their organization is often so entire that there is no difficulty in discriminating the distinct species.

The formation of peat, when not fully submerged, happens in damp areas where the temperature is low, allowing plants to decay without rotting. It can include a variety of plants that thrive in these conditions; however, a type of moss (Sphagnum) makes up a large portion of the peat found in northern Europe's marshes. This plant has the ability to produce new shoots at its top while the lower parts are decomposing.1003 Reeds, rushes, and other water plants can usually be identified in peat, and their structure is often so well-preserved that distinguishing between different species is straightforward.

719 Analysis of peat.—In general, says Sir H. Davy, one hundred parts of dry peat contain from sixty to ninety-nine parts of matter destructible by fire; and the residuum consists of earths usually of the same kind as the substratum of clay, marl, gravel, or rock, on which they are found, together with oxide of iron. "The peat of the chalk counties of England," observes the same writer, "contains much gypsum: but I have found very little in any specimens from Ireland or Scotland, and in general these peats contain very little saline matter."1004 From the researches of Dr. MacCulloch, it appears that peat is intermediate between simple vegetable matter and lignite, the conversion of peat to lignite being gradual, and being brought about by a prolonged action of water.1005

719 Analysis of peat.—Generally, Sir H. Davy notes that one hundred parts of dry peat contain between sixty and ninety-nine parts of matter that can be burned away, with the leftover material made up of earths that are typically similar to the clay, marl, gravel, or rock they sit upon, along with iron oxide. "The peat from the chalk counties of England," the same author remarks, "has a lot of gypsum, but I've found very little in samples from Ireland or Scotland, and overall, these peats have very little salt content." From Dr. MacCulloch's research, it seems that peat is in between simple organic matter and lignite, with the transformation of peat into lignite happening gradually due to long-term exposure to water.

Peat abundant in cold and humid climates.—Peat is sometimes formed on a declivity in mountainous regions, where there is much moisture; but in such situations it rarely, if ever, exceeds four feet in thickness. In bogs, and in low grounds into which alluvial peat is drifted, it is found forty feet thick, and upwards; but in such cases it generally owes one half of its volume to the water which it contains. It has seldom, if ever, been discovered within the tropics; and it rarely occurs in the valleys, even in the south of France and Spain. It abounds more and more, in proportion as we advance farther from the equator, and becomes not only more frequent but more inflammable in northern latitudes.1006

Peat is abundant in cold and humid climates.—Peat sometimes forms on slopes in mountainous areas where there's a lot of moisture, but it rarely, if ever, exceeds four feet in thickness in those locations. In bogs and lowlands where alluvial peat is deposited, it can be found at thicknesses of forty feet or more; however, in these cases, it usually contains about half of its volume in water. It has seldom, if ever, been found in tropical regions, and it's uncommon in valleys, even in southern France and Spain. It becomes more abundant as we move farther from the equator and is not only more frequent but also more flammable in northern latitudes.1006

The same phenomenon is repeated in the southern hemisphere. No peat is found in Brazil, nor even in the swampy parts of the country drained by the La Plata on the east side of South America, or in the island of Chiloe on the west; yet when we reach the 45th degree of latitude and examine the Chonos Archipelago or the Falkland Islands, and Tierra del Fuego, we meet with an abundant growth of this substance. Almost all plants contribute here by their decay to the production of peat, even the grasses; but it is a singular fact, says Mr. Darwin, as contrasted with what occurs in Europe, that no kind of moss enters into the composition of the South American peat, which is formed by many plants, but chiefly by that called by Brown Astelia pumila.1007

The same phenomenon occurs in the southern hemisphere. No peat is found in Brazil or even in the swampy areas of the country drained by the La Plata on the east side of South America, or on the island of Chiloe on the west; however, when we reach the 45th degree of latitude and look at the Chonos Archipelago or the Falkland Islands, and Tierra del Fuego, we find plenty of this substance. Almost all plants contribute to the formation of peat here through their decay, including the grasses; but it’s an interesting point, as noted by Mr. Darwin, compared to what happens in Europe, that no type of moss is part of the South American peat, which is formed by many plants but mainly by the one known by Brown as Astelia pumila.1007

I learn from Dr. Forchhammer (1849) that water charged with vegetable matter in solution does not throw down a deposit of peat in countries where the mean temperature of the year is above 43° or 44° Fahrenheit. Frost causes the precipitation of such peaty matter, but in warm climates the attraction of the carbon for the oxygen of the air mechanically mixed with the water increases with the increasing temperature, and the dissolved vegetable matter or humic acid (which is organic matter in a progressive state of decomposition) being converted into carbonic acid, rises and is absorbed into the atmosphere, and thus disappears.

I learned from Dr. Forchhammer (1849) that water mixed with plant material in solution doesn’t create a peat deposit in regions where the average annual temperature is above 43° or 44° Fahrenheit. Frost causes the peaty material to precipitate, but in warmer climates, the attraction of carbon to the oxygen in the air that is mixed with the water increases as the temperature rises. The dissolved plant matter or humic acid (which is organic material that is decomposing) gets converted into carbon dioxide, rises, and is absorbed into the atmosphere, causing it to disappear.

720 Extent of surface covered by peat.—There is a vast extent of surface in Europe covered with peat, which, in Ireland, is said to extend over a tenth of the whole island. One of the mosses on the Shannon is described as being fifty miles long, by two or three broad; and the great marsh of Montoire, near the mouth of the Loire, is mentioned, by Blavier, as being more than fifty leagues in circumference. It is a curious and well-ascertained fact, that many of these mosses of the north of Europe occupy the place of forests of pine and oak, which have, many of them, disappeared within the historical era. Such changes are brought about by the fall of trees and the stagnation of water, caused by their trunks and branches obstructing the free drainage of the atmospheric waters, and giving rise to a marsh. In a warm climate, such decayed timber would immediately be removed by insects, or by putrefaction; but, in the cold temperature now prevailing in our latitudes, many examples are recorded of marshes originating in this source. Thus, in Mar forest, in Aberdeenshire, large trunks of Scotch fir, which had fallen from age and decay, were soon immured in peat, formed partly out of their perishing leaves and branches, and in part from the growth of other plants. We also learn, that the overthrow of a forest by a storm, about the middle of the seventeenth century, gave rise to a peat-moss near Lochbroom, in Ross-shire, where, in less than half a century after the fall of the trees, the inhabitants dug peat.1008 Dr. Walker mentions a similar change, when, in the year 1756, the whole wood of Drumlaurig in Dumfries-shire was overset by the wind. Such events explain the occurrence, both in Britain and on the Continent, of mosses where the trees are all broken within two or three feet of the original surface, and where their trunks all lie in the same direction.1009

720 Extent of surface covered by peat.—There’s a vast area in Europe covered with peat, which in Ireland is said to cover about a tenth of the entire island. One of the bogs on the Shannon is noted to be fifty miles long and two or three miles wide; and the large marsh of Montoire, near the mouth of the Loire, is mentioned by Blavier as being more than fifty leagues around. It's a fascinating and well-documented fact that many of these bogs in northern Europe once were forests of pine and oak, which have largely disappeared within historical times. These changes happen due to the fall of trees and the pooling of water, caused by their trunks and branches obstructing the free drainage of rainwater, which leads to the formation of a marsh. In a warm climate, such decayed wood would quickly be removed by insects or through decay; however, in the colder temperatures of our regions, there are numerous recorded instances of marshes developing from this process. For example, in Mar forest, Aberdeenshire, large trunks of Scots pine that had fallen due to age and decay were soon enveloped in peat, formed partly from their decaying leaves and branches, and partly from the growth of other plants. We also learn that a storm in the mid-seventeenth century caused a forest to fall near Lochbroom, in Ross-shire, where, less than fifty years after the trees fell, locals began digging peat.1008 Dr. Walker mentions a similar occurrence when, in 1756, the entire wood of Drumlaurig in Dumfries-shire was blown down by the wind. Such events clarify the presence of bogs both in Britain and on the Continent, where trees are found all broken within two or three feet of the ground, and their trunks are all lying in the same direction.1009

It may however be suggested in these cases, that the soil had become exhausted for trees, and that, on the principle of that natural rotation which prevails in the vegetable world, one set of plants died out and another succeeded. It is certainly a remarkable fact that in the Danish islands, and in Jutland and Holstein, fir wood of various species, especially Scotch fir, is found at the bottom of the peat-mosses, although it is well ascertained that for the last five centuries no Coniferæ have grown wild in these countries; the coniferous trees which now flourish there having been all planted towards the close of the last century.

It can be suggested in these cases that the soil had become depleted for trees, and that, following the natural cycle that occurs in the plant world, one type of plant died out while another took its place. It's certainly interesting that in the Danish islands, as well as in Jutland and Holstein, various species of fir, especially Scotch fir, are found at the bottom of the peat mosses, even though it's been well documented that no coniferous trees have grown wild in these regions for the last five centuries; the coniferous trees that are currently thriving there were all planted towards the end of the last century.

Nothing is more common than the occurrence of buried trees at the bottom of the Irish peat-mosses, as also in most of those of England, France, and Holland; and they have been so often observed with parts of their trunks standing erect, and with their roots fixed to the subsoil, that no doubt can be entertained of their having generally grown on the spot. They consist, for the most part, of the fir, the oak, and the birch: where the subsoil is clay, the remains of oak are the most abundant; where sand is the substratum, fir prevails. In the marsh of Curragh, in the Isle of Man, vast trees are discovered standing firm on 721 their roots, though at the depth of eighteen or twenty feet below the surface. Some naturalists have desired to refer the imbedding of timber in peat-mosses to aqueous transportation, since rivers are well known to float wood into lakes; but the facts above mentioned show that, in numerous instances, such an hypothesis is inadmissible. It has, moreover, been observed, that in Scotland, as also in many parts of the Continent, the largest trees are found in those peat-mosses which lie in the least elevated regions, and that the trees are proportionally smaller in those which lie at higher levels; from which fact De Luc and Walker have both inferred that the trees grew on the spot, for they would naturally attain a greater size in lower and warmer levels. The leaves, also, and fruits of each species, are continually found immersed in the moss along with the parent trees; as, for example, the leaves and acorns of the oak, the cones and leaves of the fir, and the nuts of the hazel.

Nothing is more common than the discovery of buried trees at the bottom of Irish peat bogs, as well as in many of those in England, France, and Holland. They have often been found with parts of their trunks standing upright and their roots anchored in the subsoil, leaving no doubt that they generally grew right there. The trees mainly consist of fir, oak, and birch. Where the subsoil is clay, oak remains are the most abundant; where sand is the base, fir is more common. In the Curragh marsh on the Isle of Man, massive trees are found standing solid on their roots, even at a depth of eighteen or twenty feet below the surface. Some naturalists have suggested that the presence of timber in peat bogs could be due to water transportation since rivers are known to carry wood to lakes. However, the facts mentioned above indicate that this theory is not valid in many cases. Additionally, it has been noted that in Scotland, as well as in various parts of the continent, the largest trees are found in the peat bogs located in the lowest regions, while those in higher areas tend to be smaller. Based on this observation, both De Luc and Walker have concluded that the trees grew in their current locations, as they would naturally reach a greater size in lower and warmer areas. Furthermore, leaves and fruits from each species are frequently found buried in the moss along with the parent trees, including oak leaves and acorns, fir cones and leaves, and hazelnuts.

Recent origin of some peat-mosses.—In Hatfield moss, in Yorkshire, which appears clearly to have been a forest eighteen hundred years ago, fir-trees have been found ninety feet long, and sold for masts and keels of ships; oaks have also been discovered there above one hundred feet long. The dimensions of an oak from this moss are given in the Philosophical Transactions, No. 275, which must have been larger than any tree now existing in the British dominions.

Recent origin of some peat-mosses.—In Hatfield moss, in Yorkshire, which is clearly shown to have been a forest eighteen hundred years ago, fir trees measuring ninety feet long have been found and sold for ship masts and keels. Oaks over one hundred feet long have also been discovered there. The size of an oak from this moss is mentioned in the Philosophical Transactions, No. 275, and it must have been larger than any tree currently existing in the British territories.

In the same moss of Hatfield, as well as in that of Kincardine, in Scotland, and several others, Roman roads have been found covered to the depth of eight feet by peat. All the coins, axes, arms, and other utensils found in British and French mosses, are also Roman; so that a considerable portion of the peat in European peat-bogs is evidently not more ancient than the age of Julius Cæsar. Nor can any vestiges of the ancient forests described by that general, along the line of the great Roman way in Britain, be discovered, except in the ruined trunks of trees in peat.

In the same moss of Hatfield, as well as in that of Kincardine in Scotland and several other places, Roman roads have been found covered by eight feet of peat. All the coins, axes, weapons, and other tools discovered in British and French mosses are also Roman, indicating that a significant portion of the peat in European peat bogs is clearly not older than the time of Julius Caesar. There are no signs of the ancient forests described by that general along the route of the great Roman road in Britain, except for the decayed trunks of trees found in the peat.

De Luc ascertained that the very sites of the aboriginal forests of Hercinia, Semana, Ardennes, and several others, are now occupied by mosses and fens; and a great part of these changes have, with much probability, been attributed to the strict orders given by Severus, and other emperors, to destroy all the wood in the conquered provinces. Several of the British forests, however, which are now mosses, were cut at different periods, by order of the English parliament, because they harbored wolves or outlaws. Thus the Welsh woods were cut and burned, in the reign of Edward I.; as were many of those in Ireland, by Henry II., to prevent the natives from harboring in them, and harassing his troops.

De Luc found that the original forest areas of Hercinia, Semana, Ardennes, and several others are now taken over by moss and wetlands; and a significant part of these changes has likely been caused by the strict orders from Severus and other emperors to clear all the trees in the conquered provinces. However, several of the British forests that are now wetlands were cleared at different times by order of the English parliament because they were hiding places for wolves or outlaws. For instance, the Welsh woods were cut down and burned during the reign of Edward I; and many in Ireland were cleared by Henry II to stop the locals from using them as hiding spots and harassing his troops.

It is curious to reflect that considerable tracts have, by these accidents, been permanently sterilized, and that, during a period when civilization has been making great progress, large areas in Europe have, by human agency, been rendered less capable of administering to the wants of man. Rennie observes,1010 with truth, that in those regions 722 alone which the Roman eagle never reached—in the remote circles of the German empire, in Poland and Prussia, and still more in Norway, Sweden, and the vast empire of Russia—can we see what Europe was before it yielded to the power of Rome. Desolation now reigns where stately forests of pine and oak once flourished, such as might now have supplied all the navies of Europe with timber.

It's interesting to think that significant areas have been permanently damaged by these incidents, and that, during a time when civilization has been advancing, large parts of Europe have, through human actions, become less able to meet the needs of people. Rennie points out,1010 correctly, that in those places 722 where the Roman eagle never soared—in the distant parts of the German empire, in Poland and Prussia, and even more so in Norway, Sweden, and the vast empire of Russia—we can see what Europe was like before it fell under the influence of Rome. Now, desolation prevails where grand forests of pine and oak once thrived, forests that could have provided timber for all the navies of Europe.

Sources of bog iron-ore.—At the bottom of peat-mosses there is sometimes found a cake, or "pan," as it is termed, of oxide of iron, and the frequency of bog iron-ore is familiar to the mineralogist. The oak, which is so often dyed black in peat, owes its color to the same metal. From what source the iron is derived has often been a subject of discussion, until the discoveries of Ehrenberg seem at length to have removed the difficulty. He had observed in the marshes about Berlin a substance of a deep ochre yellow passing into red, which covered the bottom of the ditches, and which, where it had become dry after the evaporation of the water, appeared exactly Fig. 101.Gaillonella ferruginea. Gaillonella ferruginea.
a. 2000 times magnified.
like oxide of iron. But under the microscope it was found to consist of slender articulated threads or plates, partly siliceous and partly ferruginous, of what he considered an animalcule, Gaillonella ferruginea, but which most naturalists now regard as a plant.1011 There can be little doubt, therefore, that bog iron-ore consists of an aggregate of millions of these organic bodies invisible to the naked eye.1012

Sources of bog iron-ore.—At the bottom of peat bogs, you can sometimes find a layer, or "pan," of iron oxide, and the presence of bog iron-ore is well known to mineralogists. The oak, which often turns black in peat, gets its color from the same metal. The source of this iron has been a topic of debate until Ehrenberg's discoveries seem to have clarified things. He noticed a substance in the marshes around Berlin that was a deep ochre yellow shifting to red, which covered the bottoms of ditches and looked exactly like iron oxide when it dried out after the water evaporated. Fig. 101.Gaillonella ferruginea. Gaillonella ferruginea.
a. Magnified 2000 times.
However, under the microscope, it turned out to be made up of thin, jointed threads or plates, partly silicon and partly iron-rich, which he thought came from a tiny organism, Gaillonella ferruginea, but most naturalists today view it as a plant.1011 There is little doubt, then, that bog iron-ore consists of countless millions of these organic bodies that are invisible to the naked eye.1012

Preservation of animal substances in peat.—One interesting circumstance attending the history of peat mosses is the high state of preservation of animal substances buried in them for periods of many years. In June, 1747, the body of a woman was found six feet deep, in a peat-moor in the Isle of Axholm, in Lincolnshire. The antique sandals on her feet afforded evidence of her having been buried there for many ages: yet her nails, hair, and skin, are described as having shown hardly any marks of decay. On the estate of the Earl of Moira, in Ireland, a human body was dug up, a foot deep in gravel, covered with eleven feet of moss; the body was completely clothed and the garments seemed all to be made of hair. Before the use of wool was known in that country the clothing of the inhabitants was made of hair, so that it would appear that this body had been buried at that early period; yet it was fresh and unimpaired.1013 In the Philosophical Transactions we find an example recorded of the bodies of two persons having been buried in moist peat, in Derbyshire, in 1674, about a yard deep, which were examined twenty-eight years and nine months afterwards; "the color of their skin was fair and natural, their flesh soft as that of persons newly dead."1014

Preservation of animal substances in peat.—One interesting fact about peat mosses is how well they preserve animal materials buried in them for many years. In June 1747, the body of a woman was discovered six feet down in a peat bog on the Isle of Axholm in Lincolnshire. The ancient sandals on her feet indicated she had been buried there for a long time, yet her nails, hair, and skin showed almost no signs of decay. On the estate of the Earl of Moira in Ireland, a human body was found a foot deep in gravel, covered by eleven feet of moss; the body was fully clothed, and the clothing appeared to be made entirely of hair. Before wool was used in that region, people made their clothes from hair, suggesting this body had been buried during that time; still, it was remarkably fresh and intact.1013 In the Philosophical Transactions, there’s a record of two bodies buried in moist peat in Derbyshire in 1674 at about a yard deep, which were examined twenty-eight years and nine months later; "the color of their skin was fair and natural, their flesh soft as that of persons newly dead."1014

Among other analogous facts we may mention, that in digging a pit 723 for a well near Dulverton, in Somersetshire, many pigs were found in various postures, still entire. Their shape was well preserved, the skin, which retained the hair, having assumed a dry, membranous appearance. Their whole substance was converted into a white, friable, laminated, inodorous, and tasteless substance; but which, when exposed to heat, emitted an odor precisely similar to broiled bacon.1015

Among other similar facts, we can mention that while digging a pit for a well near Dulverton in Somerset, many pigs were found in various positions, still intact. Their shape was well-preserved, and the skin, which still had hair, had taken on a dry, membranous appearance. Their entire body had turned into a white, crumbly, layered, odorless, and tasteless substance; however, when exposed to heat, it released an aroma that was exactly like cooked bacon.1015

Cause of the antiseptic property of peat.—We naturally ask whence peat derives this antiseptic property? It has been attributed by some to the carbonic and gallic acids which issue from decayed wood, as also to the presence of charred wood in the lowest strata of many peat-mosses, for charcoal is a powerful antiseptic, and capable of purifying water already putrid. Vegetable gums and resins also may operate in the same way.1016

Cause of the antiseptic property of peat.—We naturally wonder where peat gets its antiseptic property. Some believe it's due to the carbonic and gallic acids that come from decayed wood, as well as the presence of charred wood found in the lower layers of many peat bogs, since charcoal is a strong antiseptic and can purify water that has already gone bad. Plant gums and resins might also play a role in this. 1016

The tannin occasionally present in peat is the produce, says Dr. MacCulloch, of tormentilla, and some other plants; but the quantity he thinks too small, and its occurrence too casual, to give rise to effects of any importance. He hints that the soft parts of animal bodies, preserved in peat-bogs, may have been converted into adipocire by the action of water merely; an explanation which appears clearly applicable to some of the cases above enumerated.1017

The tannin found in peat sometimes comes from tormentilla and a few other plants, but Dr. MacCulloch believes the amount is too small and its presence too random to have any significant effects. He suggests that the soft tissues of animals preserved in peat bogs might have turned into adipocire simply due to the action of water, which seems to clearly explain some of the cases mentioned above.1017

Miring of quadrupeds.—The manner, however, in which peat contributes to preserve, for indefinite periods, the harder parts of terrestrial animals, is a subject of more immediate interest to the geologist. There are two ways in which animals become occasionally buried in the peat of marshy grounds; they either sink down into the semifluid mud, underlying a turfy surface upon which they have rashly ventured, or, at other times, as we shall see in the sequel, a bog "bursts," and animals may be involved in the peaty alluvium.

Miring of quadrupeds.—The way peat helps preserve the harder parts of land animals for long periods is something that interests geologists right now. Animals can get buried in peat in two ways: they might sink into the semi-liquid mud underneath a grassy surface they carelessly walked on, or sometimes, as we'll see later, a bog can "burst," and animals can get caught in the peaty sediment.

In the extensive bogs of Newfoundland, cattle are sometimes found buried with only their heads and necks above ground; and after having remained for days in this situation, they have been drawn out by ropes and saved. In Scotland, also, cattle venturing on the "quaking moss" are often mired, or "laired," as it is termed; and in Ireland, Mr. King asserts that the number of cattle which are lost in sloughs is quite incredible.1018

In the vast wetlands of Newfoundland, cattle are sometimes found stuck in the mud with only their heads and necks above ground; after being in this situation for days, they are pulled out with ropes and rescued. In Scotland, cattle that venture onto the "quaking moss" often get stuck, a process known as "lairding." In Ireland, Mr. King claims that the number of cattle lost in swamps is quite astonishing.1018

Solway moss.—The description given of the Solway moss will serve to illustrate the general character of these boggy grounds. That moss, observes Gilpin, is a flat area, about seven miles in circumference, situated on the western confines of England and Scotland. Its surface is covered with grass and rushes, presenting a dry crust and a fair appearance; but it shakes under the least pressure, the bottom being unsound and semifluid. The adventurous passenger, therefore, who sometimes in dry seasons traverses this perilous waste, to save a few miles, picks his cautious way over the rushy tussocks as they appear before him, for here the soil 724 is firmest. If his foot slip, or if he venture to desert this mark of security, it is possible he may never more be heard of.

Solway moss.—The description of Solway moss illustrates the general character of these boggy areas. According to Gilpin, it's a flat expanse, about seven miles around, located on the western edge of England and Scotland. Its surface is covered with grass and rushes, giving it a dry crust and decent appearance; however, it shifts under the slightest pressure, as the ground underneath is unstable and semi-liquid. Thus, an adventurous traveler, who occasionally crosses this risky terrain during dry seasons to save a few miles, carefully picks his way over the tussocks as they come into view, since here the soil 724 is the firmest. If he slips or strays from this safe ground, he might never be heard from again.

"At the battle of Solway, in the time of Henry VIII. (1542), when the Scotch army, commanded by Oliver Sinclair, was routed, an unfortunate troop of horse, driven by their fears, plunged into this morass, which instantly closed upon them. The tale was traditional, but it is now authenticated; a man and horse, in complete armor, having been found by peat-diggers, in the place where it was always supposed the affair had happened. The skeleton of each was well preserved, and the different parts of the armor easily distinguished."1019

"At the Battle of Solway, during the reign of Henry VIII in 1542, the Scottish army led by Oliver Sinclair was defeated. A group of cavalry, frightened, rushed into a swamp that immediately engulfed them. This story was passed down through generations, but it's now been confirmed; a man and horse in full armor were discovered by peat diggers exactly where people always believed the incident took place. Both skeletons were well-preserved, and the various pieces of armor were easily identifiable." 1019

The same moss, on the 16th of December, 1772, having been filled like a great sponge with water during heavy rains, swelled to an unusual height above the surrounding country, and then burst. The turfy covering seemed for a time to act like the skin of a bladder retaining the fluid within, till it forced a passage for itself, when a stream of black half-consolidated mud began at first to creep over the plain, resembling, in the rate of its progress, an ordinary lava-current. No lives were lost, but the deluge totally overwhelmed some cottages, and covered 400 acres. The highest parts of the original moss subsided to the depth of about twenty-five feet; and the height of the moss, on the lowest parts of the country which it invaded, was at least fifteen feet.

The same moss, on December 16, 1772, had absorbed water like a giant sponge during heavy rains, swelling to an unusual height above the surrounding land before bursting. The grassy layer seemed for a while to act like the skin of a bladder holding the liquid inside until it forced a way out, causing a stream of black, semi-solid mud to begin creeping over the plain, moving at a speed similar to that of regular lava flows. No lives were lost, but the flood completely overwhelmed some cottages and covered 400 acres. The highest parts of the original moss sank about twenty-five feet, while the height of the moss in the lowest areas it invaded was at least fifteen feet.

Bursting of a peat-moss in Ireland.—A recent inundation in Sligo (January, 1831), affords another example of this phenomenon. After a sudden thaw of snow, the bog between Bloomfield and Geevah gave way; and a black deluge, carrying with it the contents of a hundred acres of bog, took the direction of a small stream and rolled on with the violence of a torrent, sweeping along heath, timber, mud, and stones, and overwhelming many meadows and arable land. On passing through some boggy land, the flood swept out a wide and deep ravine, and part of the road leading from Bloomfield to St. James's Well was completely carried away from below the foundation for the breadth of 200 yards.

Bursting of a peat-moss in Ireland.—A recent flood in Sligo (January, 1831) provides another example of this phenomenon. After a sudden thaw of snow, the bog between Bloomfield and Geevah collapsed; a dark torrent emerged, carrying away the contents of a hundred acres of bog, flowing toward a small stream and rushing on with the intensity of a flood, sweeping up heather, timber, mud, and stones, and inundating many meadows and farmland. As it passed through some marshy land, the flood carved out a wide and deep ravine, and part of the road from Bloomfield to St. James's Well was completely washed away for a stretch of 200 yards.

Great Dismal Swamp.—I have described, in my Travels in North America,1020 an extensive swamp or morass, forty miles long from north to south, and twenty-five wide, between the towns of Norfolk in Virginia, and Weldon in North Carolina. It is called the "Great Dismal," and has somewhat the appearance of an inundated river-plain covered with aquatic trees and shrubs, the soil being as black as that of a peat bog. It is higher on all sides except one than the surrounding country, towards which it sends forth streams of water to the north, east, and south, receiving a supply from the west only. In its centre it rises 12 feet above the flat region which bounds it. The soil, to the depth of 15 feet, is formed of vegetable matter without any admixture, of earthy particles, and offers an exception to a general rule before alluded to, namely, that such peaty accumulations scarcely ever occur so far south as lat. 36°, or in any region where the summer heat is so great as in Virginia. In digging 725 canals through the morass for the purpose of obtaining timber, much of the black soil has been thrown out from time to time, and exposed to the sun and air, in which case it soon rots away so that nothing remains behind, showing clearly that it owes its preservation to the shade afforded by a luxuriant vegetation and to the constant evaporation of the spongy soil by which the air is cooled during the hot months. The surface of the bog is carpeted with mosses, and densely covered with ferns and reeds, above which many evergreen shrubs and trees flourish, especially the White Cedar (Cupressus thyoides), which stands firmly supported by its long tap roots in the softest parts of the quagmire. Over the whole the deciduous cypress (Taxodium distichum) is seen to tower with its spreading top, in full leaf in the season when the sun's rays are hottest, and when, if not intercepted by a screen of foliage, they might soon cause the fallen leaves and dead plants of the preceding autumn to decompose, instead of adding their contributions to the peaty mass. On the surface of the wide morass lie innumerable trunks of large and tall trees, while thousands of others, blown down by the winds, are buried at various depths in the black mire below. They remind the geologist of the prostrate position of large stems of Sigillaria and Lepidodendron, converted into coal in ancient carboniferous rocks.

Great Dismal Swamp.—I have described, in my Travels in North America,1020 a vast swamp or marsh that stretches forty miles from north to south and twenty-five miles wide, located between the towns of Norfolk in Virginia and Weldon in North Carolina. It’s called the "Great Dismal" and resembles an flooded river plain covered with aquatic trees and shrubs, with soil as black as that found in a peat bog. It is higher on all sides except for one, where it sends streams of water flowing north, east, and south while only receiving water from the west. At its center, it rises 12 feet above the surrounding flatlands. The soil, extending 15 feet deep, is made up entirely of organic matter without any soil particles mixed in, showing an exception to the general rule mentioned before, that such peaty accumulations rarely exist so far south as latitude 36°, or in any area with the intense summer heat found in Virginia. When canals have been dug through the marsh to harvest timber, much of the black soil gets exposed to the sun and air, causing it to quickly decay and leaving nothing behind. This clearly indicates that its preservation relies on the shade provided by lush vegetation and the continuous evaporation from the spongy soil, which cools the air during the hot months. The surface of the bog is covered with moss and thickly populated with ferns and reeds, alongside many evergreen shrubs and trees, particularly the White Cedar (Cupressus thyoides), which stands securely supported by its long tap roots in the softest parts of the swamp. Above all this, the deciduous cypress (Taxodium distichum) towers with its broad canopy, fully leafed during the hottest months, when, if not shielded by a layer of foliage, the sun’s rays could quickly decompose the fallen leaves and dead plants from the previous autumn instead of allowing them to contribute to the peaty accumulation. On the surface of the vast swamp lie countless trunks of large, tall trees, while thousands of others, knocked down by winds, rest buried at various depths in the black mire below. They remind geologists of the fallen large stems of Sigillaria and Lepidodendron, which have turned into coal in ancient carboniferous rocks.

Bones of herbivorous quadrupeds in peat.—The antlers of large and full-grown stags are amongst the most common and conspicuous remains of animals in peat. They are not horns which have been shed; for portions of the skull are found attached, proving that the whole animal perished. Bones of the ox, hog, horse, sheep, and other herbivorous animals, also occur. M. Morren has discovered in the peat of Flanders the bones of otters and beavers1021; but no remains have been met with belonging to those extinct quadrupeds, of which the living congeners inhabit warmer latitudes, such as the elephant, rhinoceros, hippopotamus, hyæna, and tiger, though these are so common in superficial deposits of silt, mud, sand, or stalactite, in various districts throughout Great Britain. Their absence seems to imply that they had ceased to live before the atmosphere of this part of the world acquired that cold and humid character which favors the growth of peat.

Bones of herbivorous quadrupeds in peat.—The antlers of large, fully grown stags are among the most common and noticeable remains of animals found in peat. They are not horns that have been shed; portions of the skull are still attached, showing that the entire animal died there. Bones of cattle, pigs, horses, sheep, and other herbivorous animals have also been discovered. M. Morren has found bones of otters and beavers in the peat of Flanders1021; however, no remains have been found belonging to those extinct quadrupeds that are related to living species found in warmer areas, such as elephants, rhinoceroses, hippopotamuses, hyenas, and tigers, even though these are commonly seen in recent deposits of silt, mud, sand, or stalactite in various regions across Great Britain. Their absence suggests that they had disappeared before the atmosphere in this part of the world became cold and humid enough to support peat growth.

Remains of ships, &c., in peat mosses.—From the facts before mentioned, that mosses occasionally burst, and descend in a fluid state to lower levels, it will readily be seen that lakes and arms of the sea may occasionally become the receptacles of drift peat. Of this, accordingly, there are numerous examples; and hence the alternations of clay and sand with different deposits of peat so frequent on some coasts, as on those of the Baltic and German Ocean. We are informed by Deguer, that remains of ships, nautical instruments, and oars, have been found in many of the Dutch mosses; and Gerard, in his History of the Valley of the Somme, mentions that in the lowest tier of that moss was found a boat loaded with bricks, proving that these mosses were at one period 726 navigable lakes and arms of the sea, as were also many mosses on the coast of Picardy, Zealand, and Friesland, from which soda and salt are procured.1022 The canoes, stone hatchets, and stone arrow-heads found in peat in different parts of Great Britain, lead to similar conclusions.

Remains of ships, etc., in peat mosses.—From the facts mentioned earlier, that mosses sometimes break apart and flow down to lower levels, it’s easy to see that lakes and coastal areas can occasionally collect drift peat. There are many examples of this; therefore, we frequently find layers of clay and sand mixed with different deposits of peat along certain coastlines, such as those of the Baltic and the North Sea. Deguer informs us that remains of ships, navigation tools, and oars have been discovered in many of the Dutch mosses. Additionally, Gerard, in his History of the Valley of the Somme, mentions that in the lowest layer of that moss, a boat loaded with bricks was found, proving that these mosses were once navigable lakes and parts of the sea, just like many mosses along the coasts of Picardy, Zealand, and Friesland, where soda and salt are obtained.1022 The canoes, stone hatchets, and stone arrowheads found in peat in various places in Great Britain lead to similar conclusions.

Imbedding of human and other remains, and works of Art, in Blown Sand.

The drifting of sand may next be considered among the causes capable of preserving organic remains and works of art on the emerged land.

The movement of sand can also be considered one of the factors that can preserve organic remains and artworks on the land that has emerged.

African Sands.—The sands of the African deserts have been driven by the west winds over part of the arable land of Egypt, on the western bank of the Nile, in those places where valleys open into the plain, or where there are gorges through the Libyan mountains. By similar sand-drifts the ruins of ancient cities have been buried between the temple of Jupiter Ammon and Nubia. M. G. A. De Luc attempted to infer the recent origin of our continents, from the fact that these moving sands have arrived only in modern times at the fertile plains of the Nile. The same scourge, he said, would have afflicted Egypt for ages anterior to the times of history, had the continents risen above the level of the sea several hundred centuries before our era.1023 But the author proceeded in this, as in all his other chronological computations, on a multitude of gratuitous assumptions. He ought, in the first place, to have demonstrated that the whole continent of Africa was raised above the level of the sea at one period; for unless this point was established, the region from whence the sands began to move might have been the last addition made to Africa, and the commencement of the sand-flood might have been long posterior to the laying dry of the greater portion of that continent. That the different parts of Europe were not all elevated at one time is now generally admitted. De Luc should also have pointed out the depth of drift sand in various parts of the great Libyan deserts, and have shown whether any valleys of large dimensions had been filled up—how long these may have arrested the progress of the sands, and how far the flood had upon the whole advanced since the times of history.

African Sands.—The sands of the African deserts have been pushed by the west winds across parts of the fertile land in Egypt, on the western bank of the Nile, especially in areas where valleys meet the plains or where there are gaps in the Libyan mountains. Similar sand drifts have buried the ruins of ancient cities between the temple of Jupiter Ammon and Nubia. M. G. A. De Luc tried to infer the recent formation of our continents based on the fact that these moving sands only reached the fertile Nile plains in modern times. He argued that the same disaster would have impacted Egypt long before recorded history if the continents had risen above sea level several hundred centuries before our era.1023 However, the author based his conclusions, like all his other chronological calculations, on numerous unsupported assumptions. First, he should have proven that the entire continent of Africa was raised above sea level at the same time; because unless this was established, the area from which the sands began to move could have been the last part added to Africa, and the start of the sand movement might have occurred long after most of that continent had emerged from the sea. It is now widely accepted that different regions of Europe were not all raised at once. De Luc should have also noted the thickness of drift sand in various parts of the vast Libyan deserts and demonstrated whether any large valleys had been filled in—how long these might have slowed the spread of the sands, and how far the movement had progressed since the beginning of recorded history.

We have seen that Sir J. G. Wilkinson is of opinion that, while the sand-drift is making aggressions at certain points upon the fertile soil of Egypt, the alluvial deposit of the Nile is advancing very generally upon the desert; and that, upon the whole, the balance is greatly in favor of the fertilizing mud.1024

We have seen that Sir J. G. Wilkinson believes that, while sand is encroaching on some areas of Egypt's fertile soil, the alluvial deposits from the Nile are spreading more broadly into the desert; overall, the situation heavily favors the enriching mud.1024

No mode of interment can be conceived, more favorable to the conservation of monuments for indefinite periods than that now so common in the region immediately westward of the Nile. The sand which surrounded and filled the great temple of Ipsambul, first discovered by 727 Burckhardt, and afterwards partially uncovered by Belzoni and Beechey, was so fine as to resemble a fluid when put in motion. Neither the features of the colossal figures, nor the color of the stucco with which some were covered, nor the paintings on the walls, had received any injury from being enveloped for ages in this dry impalpable dust.1025

No method of burial can be imagined that is better for preserving monuments over long periods than the one commonly found in the area just west of the Nile. The sand that surrounded and filled the great temple of Ipsambul, first discovered by Burckhardt and later partly uncovered by Belzoni and Beechey, was so fine it looked like a fluid when disturbed. Neither the details of the colossal figures, nor the color of the stucco covering some of them, nor the paintings on the walls were harmed at all from being buried for centuries in this dry, fine dust.1025

At some future period, perhaps when the pyramids shall have perished, the action of the sea, or an earthquake, may lay open to the day some of these buried temples. Or we may suppose the desert to remain undisturbed, and changes in the surrounding sea and land to modify the climate and the direction of the prevailing winds, so that these may then waft away the Libyan sands as gradually as they once brought them to those regions. Thus, many a town and temple of higher antiquity than Thebes or Memphis may reappear in their original antiquity, and a part of the gloom which overhangs the history of the earlier nations be dispelled.

At some point in the future, maybe when the pyramids have crumbled, the sea or an earthquake could uncover some of these hidden temples. Or we might imagine the desert staying undisturbed, while changes in the nearby sea and land alter the climate and the direction of the winds, allowing them to slowly blow away the Libyan sands just as they once brought them to those areas. As a result, many towns and temples older than Thebes or Memphis might emerge in their original form, lifting some of the darkness that shrouds the history of the earlier civilizations.

Whole caravans are said to have been overwhelmed by the Libyan sands; and Burckhardt informs us that "after passing the Akaba near the head of the Red Sea, the bones of dead camels are the only guides of the pilgrim through the wastes of sand."—"We did not see," says Captain Lyon, speaking of a plain near the Soudah mountains, in Northern Africa, "the least appearance of vegetation; but observed many skeletons of animals, which had died of fatigue on the desert, and occasionally the grave of some human being. All these bodies were so dried by the heat of the sun, that putrefaction appears not to have taken place after death. In recently expired animals I could not perceive the slightest offensive smell; and in those long dead, the skin with the hair on it remained unbroken and perfect, although so brittle as to break with a slight blow. The sand-winds never cause these carcases to change their places; for, in a short time, a slight mound is formed round them, and they become stationary."1026

Whole caravans are said to have been buried by the Libyan sands; and Burckhardt tells us that "after passing the Akaba near the head of the Red Sea, the bones of dead camels are the only guides for the traveler through the vast sand wastes."—"We did not see," says Captain Lyon, referring to a plain near the Soudah mountains in Northern Africa, "any sign of vegetation; but we noticed many animal skeletons that had died from exhaustion in the desert, and occasionally the grave of a human being. All these bodies were so dried out by the sun’s heat that decay appears not to have occurred after death. In animals that had just died, I could not smell the slightest offensive odor; and in those long deceased, the skin with the hair still intact remained unbroken and perfect, although so fragile it would shatter with a light touch. The sand-winds never move these carcasses; instead, in a short time, a slight mound forms around them, and they become stationary." 1026

Towns overwhelmed by sand floods.—The burying of several towns and villages in England, France, and Jutland, by blown sand, is on record; thus, for example, near St. Pol de Leon, in Brittany, a whole village was completely buried beneath drift sand, so that nothing was seen but the spire of the church.1027 In Jutland marine shells adhering to sea-weed are sometimes blown by the violence of the wind to the height of 100 feet, and buried in similar hills of sand.

Towns overwhelmed by sand floods.—Several towns and villages in England, France, and Jutland have been buried by blown sand. For instance, near St. Pol de Leon in Brittany, an entire village was completely covered by drifting sand, leaving only the church spire visible.1027 In Jutland, marine shells attached to seaweed can sometimes be blown up to 100 feet high by strong winds, and get buried in similar sand hills.

In Suffolk, in the year 1688, part of Downham was overwhelmed by sands which had broken loose about 100 years before, from a warren five miles to the south-west. This sand had, in the course of a century, travelled five miles, and covered more than 1000 acres of land.1028 A considerable tract of cultivated land on the north coast of Cornwall has been inundated by drift sand, forming hills several hundred feet above the 728 level of the sea, and composed of comminuted marine shells, in which some terrestrial shells are enclosed entire. By the shifting of these sands the ruins of ancient buildings have been discovered; and in some cases where wells have been bored to a great depth, distinct strata, separated by a vegetable crust, are visible. In some places, as at New Quay, large masses have become sufficiently indurated to be used for architectural purposes. The lapidification, which is still in progress, appears to be due to oxide of iron held in solution by the water which percolates the sand.1029

In Suffolk, in 1688, part of Downham was buried by sand that had broken loose about 100 years earlier from a warren five miles to the southwest. This sand traveled five miles over the course of a century and covered more than 1,000 acres of land.1028 A significant area of farmland on the north coast of Cornwall has been covered by drifting sand, forming hills several hundred feet above sea level, made up of crushed marine shells, in which some land shells are completely intact. As these sands shifted, the ruins of ancient buildings were uncovered; in some cases, where wells have been drilled to considerable depths, distinct layers separated by a layer of vegetation are visible. In certain locations, like New Quay, large sections have hardened enough to be used for construction. The process of hardening, which is still ongoing, seems to be caused by iron oxide dissolved in water that seeps through the sand.1029

Imbedding of Organic and other Remains in Volcanic Formations on the Land.

I have in some degree anticipated the subject of this section in former chapters, when speaking of the buried cities around Naples, and those on the flanks of Etna (pp. 385. 400.). From the facts referred to, it appeared that the preservation of human remains and works of art is frequently due to the descent of floods caused by the copious rains which accompany eruptions. These aqueous lavas, as they are called in Campania, flow with great rapidity, and in 1822 surprised and suffocated, as was stated, seven persons in the villages of St. Sebastian and Massa, on the flanks of Vesuvius.

I have somewhat covered the topic of this section in previous chapters when discussing the buried cities around Naples and those on the slopes of Etna (pp. 385. 400.). Based on the facts mentioned, it seems that the preservation of human remains and works of art is often due to the floods caused by the heavy rains that come with eruptions. These watery lavas, as they're called in Campania, flow quickly, and in 1822, as noted, seven people were caught off guard and suffocated in the villages of St. Sebastian and Massa, located on the slopes of Vesuvius.

In the tuffs, moreover, or solidified mud, deposited by these aqueous lavas, impressions of leaves and of trees have been observed. Some of those, formed after the eruption of Vesuvius in 1822, are now preserved in the museum at Naples.

In the tuffs, or solidified mud, left by these water-based lavas, impressions of leaves and trees have been found. Some of those, made after the eruption of Vesuvius in 1822, are now kept in the museum in Naples.

Lava itself may become indirectly the means of preserving terrestrial remains, by overflowing beds of ashes, pumice, and ejected matter, which may have been showered down upon animals and plants, or upon human remains. Few substances are better non-conductors of heat than volcanic dust and scoriæ, so that a bed of such materials is rarely melted by a superimposed lava-current. After consolidation, the lava affords secure protection to the lighter and more removable mass below, in which the organic relics may be enveloped. The Herculanean tuffs containing the rolls of papyrus, of which the characters are still legible, have, as was before remarked, been for ages covered by lava.

Lava can indirectly help preserve remains on land by flowing over layers of ash, pumice, and other debris that may have fallen on animals, plants, or human remains. Few materials are better at insulating against heat than volcanic dust and scoria, so a layer of these materials is rarely melted by lava flowing on top. Once solidified, the lava provides strong protection for the lighter and more easily disturbed material underneath, where organic remains can be preserved. The tuffs from Herculaneum, which contain rolls of papyrus with still legible writing, have, as mentioned earlier, been covered by lava for centuries.

Another mode by which lava may tend to the conservation of imbedded remains, at least of works of human art, is by its overflowing them when it is not intensely heated, in which case they sometimes suffer little or no injury.

Another way that lava can help preserve embedded remains, particularly human-made works, is by overflowing them when it's not extremely hot, in which case they often endure little or no damage.

Thus when the Etnean lava-current of 1669 covered fourteen towns and villages, and part of the city of Catania, it did not melt down a great number of statues and other articles in the vaults of Catania; and at the depth of thirty-five feet in the same current, on the site of Mompiliere, one of the buried towns, the bell of a church and some statues were found uninjured (p. 401.).

Thus, when the Etnean lava flow of 1669 covered fourteen towns and villages, along with part of the city of Catania, it didn't destroy many statues and other items in the vaults of Catania. At a depth of thirty-five feet in the same flow, at the site of Mompiliere, one of the buried towns, the bell of a church and some statues were found unharmed (p. 401.).

729 We read of several buried cities in Central India, and among others of Oujein (or Oojain) which about fifty years before the Christian era was the seat of empire, of art, and of learning; but which in the time of the Rajah Vicramaditya, was overwhelmed, according to tradition, together with more than eighty other large towns in the provinces of Malwa and Bagur, "by a shower of earth." The city which now bears the name is situated a mile to the southward of the ancient town. On digging on the spot where the latter is supposed to have stood, to the depth of fifteen or eighteen feet, there are frequently discovered, says Mr. Hunter, entire brick walls, pillars of stone, and pieces of wood of an extraordinary hardness, besides utensils of various kinds, ancient coins, and occasionally buried wheat in a state resembling charcoal.1030

729 We read about several buried cities in Central India, including Oujein (or Oojain), which around fifty years before the Christian era was the center of empire, art, and learning. However, during the time of Rajah Vicramaditya, it was supposedly buried along with more than eighty other large towns in the provinces of Malwa and Bagur "by a shower of earth." The city that exists today is located about a mile south of the ancient town. When excavating at the site where the ancient city is believed to have been, to a depth of fifteen or eighteen feet, there are often discoveries of complete brick walls, stone pillars, and pieces of exceptionally hard wood, as well as various utensils, ancient coins, and occasionally wheat buried in a charcoal-like state, according to Mr. Hunter.1030

The soil which covers Oujein is described as "being of an ash-gray color, with minute specks of black sand."1031 And the "shower of earth," said to have "fallen from heaven," has been attributed by some travellers to volcanic agency. There are, however, no active volcanoes in Central India, the nearest to Oujein being Denodur hill near Bhooj, the capital of Cutch, 300 geographical miles distant, if indeed that hill has ever poured out lava in historical times, which is doubted by many.1032 The latest writers on Oujein avow their suspicion that the supposed "catastrophe" was nothing more than the political decline and final abandonment of a great city which, like Nineveh or Babylon, and many an ancient seat of empire in the East, after losing its importance as a metropolis, became a heap of ruins. The rapidity with which the sun-dried bricks, of which even the most splendid oriental palaces are often constructed, crumble down when exposed to rain and sun, and are converted into mounds of ordinary earth and clay, is well known. According to Captain Dangerfield, trap tuff and columnar basalt constitute the rocks in the environs of Oujein1033, and the volcanic nature of these formations, from which the materials of the bricks were originally derived, may have led to the idea of the city having been overwhelmed by a volcanic eruption.

The soil covering Oujein is said to be "ash-gray, with tiny specks of black sand."1031 The "shower of earth," which is claimed to have "fallen from heaven," has been attributed by some travelers to volcanic activity. However, there are no active volcanoes in Central India, the closest being Denodur hill near Bhooj, the capital of Cutch, which is 300 geographic miles away, if that hill ever erupted in historical times, a claim many doubt.1032 Recent writers on Oujein express skepticism that the supposed "catastrophe" was anything more than the political decline and eventual abandonment of a great city, similar to Nineveh or Babylon, which after losing its status as a major city, became a pile of ruins. It's well-known how quickly sun-dried bricks, which even the most impressive Oriental palaces are often made of, crumble when exposed to rain and sun, turning into mounds of regular earth and clay. According to Captain Dangerfield, the rocks surrounding Oujein1033 consist of trap tuff and columnar basalt, and the volcanic nature of these formations, from which the materials for the bricks were originally sourced, may have sparked the idea that the city was buried by a volcanic eruption.


CHAPTER XLVI.

BURYING OF FOSSILS IN ALLUVIAL DEPOSITS AND IN CAVES.

Fossils in alluvium—Effects of sudden inundations—terrestrial animals most abundantly preserved in alluvium where earthquakes prevail—Marine alluvium—Buried town—Effects of Landslips—Organic remains in fissures and caves—Form and dimensions of caverns—their probable origin—Closed basins and subterranean rivers of the Morea—Katavothra—Formation of breccias with red cement—Human remains imbedded in Morea—Intermixture, in caves of South of France and elsewhere, of human remains and bones of extinct quadrupeds, no proof of former co-existence of man with those lost species.

Fossils in river sediments—Impact of sudden floods—terrestrial animals are most commonly found preserved in river sediments where earthquakes are frequent—Marine sediments—Buried towns—Effects of landslides—Organic remains in cracks and caves—Shape and size of caverns—their likely origin—Closed basins and underground rivers of the Morea—Katavothra—Formation of breccias with red cement—Human remains found in the Morea—Mixing, in caves in the south of France and elsewhere, of human remains and bones of extinct mammals, no evidence of humans coexisting with those lost species.

Fossils in alluvium.—The next subject for our consideration, according to the division before proposed, is the embedding of organic bodies in alluvium.

Fossils in alluvium.—The next topic for us to explore, based on the earlier framework, is the embedding of organic materials in alluvium.

The gravel, sand, and mud in the bed of a river does not often contain any animal or vegetable remains; for the whole mass is so continually shifting its place, and the attrition of the various parts is so great, that even the hardest rocks contained in it are, at length, ground down to powder. But when sand and sediment are suddenly swept by a flood, and then let fall upon the land, such an alluvium may envelop trees or the remains of animals, which, in this manner, are often permanently preserved. In the mud and sand produced by the floods in Scotland, in 1829, the dead and mutilated bodies of hares, rabbits, moles, mice, partridges, and even the bodies of men, were found partially buried.1034 But in these and similar cases one flood usually effaces the memorials left by another, and there is rarely a sufficient depth of undisturbed transported matter, in any one spot, to preserve the organic remains for ages from destruction.

The gravel, sand, and mud at the bottom of a river usually don’t contain any animal or plant remains. This is because the entire mass is constantly shifting, and the wear and tear between the different materials is so significant that even the hardest rocks eventually get ground down to powder. However, when a flood suddenly sweeps away sand and sediment and deposits it on land, this alluvium can cover trees or the remains of animals, which can sometimes be preserved for a long time. In the mud and sand from the floods in Scotland in 1829, the dead and mutilated bodies of hares, rabbits, moles, mice, partridges, and even people were found partially buried.1034 But in these cases and similar ones, one flood usually erases the traces left by another, and it’s rare to find a deep enough layer of undisturbed sediment in any one spot to protect organic remains from destruction for ages.

Where earthquakes prevail, and the levels of a country are changed from time to time, the remains of animals may more easily be inhumed and protected from disintegration. Portions of plains, loaded with alluvial accumulations by transient floods, may be gradually upraised; and, if any organic remains have been imbedded in the transported materials, they may, after such elevation, be placed beyond the reach of the erosive power of streams. In districts where the drainage is repeatedly deranged by subterranean movements, every fissure, every hollow caused by the sinking in of land, becomes a depository of organic and inorganic substances, hurried along by transient floods.

Where earthquakes are common, and the landscape of a country changes over time, the remains of animals can be more easily buried and protected from decay. Parts of plains, piled up with sediment from temporary floods, may slowly rise; and if any organic remains have been trapped in these transported materials, they may, after this elevation, be safe from the eroding force of rivers. In areas where drainage is frequently disrupted by underground movements, every crack and every depression created by land sinking becomes a place where organic and inorganic materials are stored, carried in by temporary floods.

Marine alluvium.—In May, 1787, a dreadful inundation of the sea was caused at Coringa, Ingeram, and other places, on the coast of Coromandel, in the East Indies, by a hurricane blowing from the N. E., which raised the waters so that they rolled inland to the distance of about twenty miles from the shore, swept away many villages, drowned more 731 than 10,000 people, and left the country covered with marine mud, on which the carcasses of about 100,000 head of cattle were strewed. An old tradition of the natives of a similar flood, said to have happened about a century before, was, till this event, regarded as fabulous by the European settlers.1035 The same coast of Coromandel was, so late as May, 1832, the scene of another catastrophe of the same kind; and when the inundation subsided, several vessels were seen grounded in the fields of the low country about Coringa.

Marine alluvium.—In May 1787, a terrible flooding occurred at Coringa, Ingeram, and other locations along the Coromandel coast in the East Indies, caused by a hurricane coming from the northeast. The storm raised the sea so much that the waters surged inland for about twenty miles from the shore, destroying many villages, drowning over 10,000 people, and leaving the land covered in marine mud, with the bodies of about 100,000 cattle scattered everywhere. An old local legend about a similar flood that supposedly happened about a century earlier was considered a myth by European settlers until this disaster. 731 The same Coromandel coast experienced another similar disaster as recently as May 1832, and when the flooding receded, several ships were spotted stranded in the fields of the low-lying areas around Coringa.

Many of the storms termed hurricanes have evidently been connected with submarine earthquakes, as is shown by the atmospheric phenomena attendant on them, and by the sounds heard in the ground and the odors emitted. Such were the circumstances which accompanied the swell of the sea in Jamaica, in 1780, when a great wave desolated the western coast, and bursting upon Savanna la Mar, swept away the whole town in an instant, so that not a vestige of man, beast, or habitation, was seen upon the surface.1036

Many storms known as hurricanes have clearly been linked to underwater earthquakes, as shown by the related atmospheric phenomena, the sounds heard in the ground, and the smells released. This was the case during the sea swell in Jamaica in 1780 when a massive wave devastated the western coast, crashing into Savanna la Mar and instantly sweeping away the entire town, leaving no trace of people, animals, or buildings visible on the surface.1036

Houses and works of art in alluvial deposits.—A very ancient subterranean town, apparently of Hindoo origin, was discovered in India in 1833, in digging the Doab canal. Its site is north of Saharunpore, near the town of Behat, and seventeen feet below the present surface of the country. More than 170 coins of silver and copper have already been found, and many articles in metal and earthenware. The overlying deposit consisted of about five feet of river sand, with a substratum about twelve feet thick of red alluvial clay. In the neighborhood are several rivers and torrents, which descend from the mountains charged with vast quantities of mud, sand, and shingle; and within the memory of persons now living the modern Behat has been threatened by an inundation, which, after retreating, left the neighboring country strewed over with a superficial covering of sand several feet thick. In sinking wells in the environs, masses of shingle and boulders have been reached resembling those now in the river-channels of the same district, under a deposit of thirty feet of reddish loam. Captain Cautley, therefore, who directed the excavations, supposes that the matter discharged by torrents has gradually raised the whole country skirting the base of the lower hills; and that the ancient town, having been originally built in a hollow, was submerged by floods, and covered over with sediment seventeen feet in thickness.1037

Houses and works of art in alluvial deposits.—A very ancient underground town, likely of Hindu origin, was discovered in India in 1833 during the digging of the Doab canal. Its location is north of Saharunpore, near the town of Behat, and it sits seventeen feet below the current surface of the area. More than 170 coins made of silver and copper have already been found, along with numerous metal and ceramic artifacts. The covering layer consisted of about five feet of river sand, with a foundation about twelve feet thick made of red alluvial clay. Nearby, there are several rivers and streams flowing down from the mountains, carrying large amounts of mud, sand, and gravel; in living memory, the modern Behat has experienced flooding, which, after receding, left the surrounding land covered with several feet of sand. While digging wells in the area, large stones and boulders have been encountered, resembling those currently found in the river channels of the same region, beneath a deposit of thirty feet of reddish soil. Captain Cautley, who oversaw the excavations, believes that the materials carried by the torrents have gradually elevated the entire area near the lower hills; and that the ancient town, originally built in a depression, was submerged by floods and covered in sediment up to seventeen feet thick.1037

We are informed, by M. Boblaye, that in the Morea, the formation termed céramique, consisting of pottery, tiles, and bricks, intermixed with various works of art, enters so largely into the alluvium and vegetable soil upon the plains of Greece, and into hard and crystalline breccias which have been formed at the foot of declivities, that it constitutes an important stratum which might, in the absence of zoological characters, serve to mark our epoch in a most indestructible manner.1038

We learned from M. Boblaye that in the Morea, the layer known as céramique, made up of pottery, tiles, and bricks mixed with various artworks, is so prevalent in the alluvium and rich soil of the plains of Greece—and in hard and crystalline breccias formed at the foot of slopes—that it represents an important layer that could, without any zoological features, reliably indicate our era in a very durable way.1038

732 Landslips.—The landslip, by suddenly precipitating large masses of rock and soil into a valley, overwhelms a multitude of animals, and sometimes buries permanently whole villages, with their inhabitants and large herds of cattle. Thus three villages, with their entire population, were covered, when the mountain of Piz fell in 1772, in the district of Treviso, in the state of Venice,1039 and part of Mount Grenier, south of Chambery, in Savoy, which fell down in the year 1248, buried five parishes, including the town and church of St. André, the ruins occupying an extent of about nine square miles.1040

732 Landslips.—A landslip can suddenly send huge amounts of rock and soil crashing into a valley, burying many animals and sometimes completely covering entire villages along with their residents and large herds of cattle. For example, in 1772, the mountain of Piz collapsed in the Treviso district of Venice, burying three villages and their entire populations. Similarly, when part of Mount Grenier fell in 1248, south of Chambery in Savoy, it buried five parishes, including the town and church of St. André, with the ruins spreading over about nine square miles.1040

The number of lives lost by the slide of the Rossberg, in Switzerland, in 1806, was estimated at more than 800, a great number of the bodies, as well as several villages and scattered houses, being buried deep under mud and rock. In the same country, several hundred cottages, with eighteen of their inhabitants and a great number of cows, goats, and sheep, were victims to the sudden fall of a bed of stones, thirty yards deep, which descended from the summits of the Diablerets in Vallais. In the year 1618, a portion of Mount Conto fell, in the county of Chiavenna, in Switzerland, and buried the town of Pleurs with all its inhabitants, to the number of 2430.

The number of lives lost in the Rossberg landslide in Switzerland in 1806 was estimated to be over 800, with many bodies, as well as several villages and scattered houses, buried deep under mud and rock. In the same country, several hundred cottages, along with eighteen of their inhabitants and a large number of cows, goats, and sheep, fell victim to the sudden collapse of a bed of stones, thirty yards deep, that came down from the Diablerets peaks in Vallais. In 1618, part of Mount Conto collapsed in Chiavenna, Switzerland, burying the town of Pleurs and all its 2,430 residents.

It is unnecessary to multiply examples of similar local catastrophes, which however numerous they may have been in mountainous parts of Europe, within the historical period, have been, nevertheless, of rare occurrence when compared to events of the same kind which have taken place in regions convulsed by earthquakes. It is then that enormous masses of rock and earth, even in comparatively low and level countries, are detached from the sides of valleys, and cast down into the river courses, and often so unexpectedly that they overwhelm, even in the daytime, every living thing upon the plains.

It’s not necessary to provide more examples of similar local disasters, which, although they may have been numerous in the mountainous areas of Europe throughout history, have still been quite rare compared to the frequent events of the same nature in regions shaken by earthquakes. It’s during these times that massive amounts of rock and earth, even in relatively flat areas, break off from the sides of valleys and tumble into riverbeds, often so suddenly that they catch everything in the plains off guard, destroying it all, even in broad daylight.

Preservation of Organic Remains in Fissures and Caves.

In the history of earthquakes it was shown that many hundreds of new fissures and chasms had opened in certain regions during the last 150 years, some of which are described as being of unfathomable depth. We also perceive that mountain masses have been violently fractured and dislocated, during their rise above the level of the sea; and thus we may account for the existence of many cavities in the interior of the earth by the simple agency of earthquakes; but there are some caverns, especially in limestone rocks, which, although usually, if not always, connected with rents, are nevertheless of such forms, and dimensions, alternately expanding into spacious chambers, and then contracting again into narrow passages, that it is difficult to conceive that they can owe their origin to the mere fracturing and displacement of solid masses.

In the history of earthquakes, it has been shown that many hundreds of new cracks and chasms have opened in certain areas over the last 150 years, some of which are described as being incredibly deep. We also notice that mountain ranges have been violently broken apart and shifted as they rose above sea level; this helps explain the existence of many cavities in the Earth's interior due to the simple action of earthquakes. However, there are some caves, particularly in limestone, that, while usually connected to fractures, have such shapes and sizes—expanding into large chambers and then narrowing into tight passages—that it’s hard to believe they just formed from the simple breaking and shifting of solid materials.

In the limestone of Kentucky, in the basin of Green River, one of the 733 tributaries of the Ohio, a line of underground cavities has been traced in one direction for a distance of ten miles, without any termination; and one of the chambers, of which there are many, all connected by narrow tunnels, is no less than ten acres in area and 150 feet in its greatest height. Besides the principal series of "antres vast," there are a great many lateral embranchments not yet explored.1041

In the limestone of Kentucky, in the Green River basin, which is a tributary of the Ohio, a series of underground cavities has been traced for ten miles in one direction without end. One of the chambers, among many that are all connected by narrow tunnels, covers an area of ten acres and reaches a height of 150 feet at its highest point. In addition to the main series of vast caves, there are many side branches that have yet to be explored.1041

The cavernous structure here alluded to is not altogether confined to calcareous rocks; for it has lately been observed in micaceous and argillaceous schist in the Grecian island of Thermia (Cythnos of the ancients), one of the Cyclades. Here also spacious halls, with rounded and irregular walls, are connected together by narrow passages or tunnels, and there are many lateral branches which have no outlet. A current of water has evidently at some period flowed through the whole, and left a muddy deposit of bluish clay upon the floor; but the erosive action of the stream cannot be supposed to have given rise to the excavations in the first instance. M. Virlet suggests that fissures were first caused by earthquakes, and that these fissures became the chimneys or vents for the disengagement of gas, generated below by volcanic heat. Gases, he observes, such as the muriatic, sulphuric, fluoric, and others, might, if raised to a high temperature, alter and decompose the rocks which they traverse. There are signs of the former action of such vapors in rents of the micaceous schist of Thermia, and thermal springs now issue from the grottoes of that island. We may suppose that afterwards the elements of the decomposed rocks were gradually removed in a state of solution by mineral waters; a theory which, according to M. Virlet, is confirmed by the effect of heated gases which escape from rents in the isthmus of Corinth, and which have greatly altered and corroded the hard siliceous and jaspideous rocks.1042

The large cavern structure mentioned here isn't just found in limestone; it has recently been spotted in mica and clay schist on the Greek island of Thermia (known as Cythnos in ancient times), which is part of the Cyclades. Here, spacious rooms with curved and uneven walls are connected by narrow paths or tunnels, and there are many side branches that lead nowhere. At some point, water certainly flowed throughout the entire area, leaving a muddy deposit of bluish clay on the floor; however, the stream's erosion isn't believed to be the initial cause of the excavations. M. Virlet proposes that earthquakes first created the fissures, which then became channels for gas released from below due to volcanic heat. He notes that gases like muriatic, sulphuric, fluoric, and others, if heated to a high temperature, could change and break down the rocks they pass through. There are indications of past action from such vapors in the cracks of the mica schist of Thermia, and thermal springs currently emerge from the grottoes on that island. We can assume that later, the materials from the decomposed rocks were slowly washed away in solution by mineral waters; a theory that M. Virlet believes is supported by the effects of heated gases escaping from fissures in the isthmus of Corinth, which have significantly altered and worn down the hard siliceous and jaspideous rocks.1042

When we reflect on the quantity of carbonate of lime annually poured out by mineral waters, we are prepared to admit that large cavities must, in the course of ages, be formed at considerable depths below the surface in calcareous rocks.1043 These rocks, it will be remembered, are at once more soluble, more permeable, and more fragile, than any others, at least all the compact varieties are very easily broken by the movements of earthquakes, which would produce only flexures in argillaceous strata. Fissures once formed in limestone are not liable, as in many other formations, to become closed up by impervious clayey matter, and hence a stream of acidulous water might for ages obtain a free and unobstructed passage.1044

When we think about the amount of calcium carbonate that mineral waters release each year, we can accept that large cavities must form deep beneath the surface in limestone. These rocks, as a reminder, are more soluble, more permeable, and more fragile than any others; at least the solid types can easily break from the movements of earthquakes, which would only cause bends in clay layers. Once fissures are created in limestone, they aren't likely to get blocked by impermeable clay like in many other formations, allowing acidic water to flow freely for ages.

Morea.—Nothing is more common in limestone districts than the engulfment of rivers, which after holding a subterranean course for many miles escape again by some new outlet. As they are usually charged 734 with fine sediment, and often with sand and pebbles where they enter, whereas they are usually pure and limpid where they flow out again, they must deposit much matter in empty spaces in the interior of the earth. In addition to the materials thus introduced, stalagmite, or carbonate of lime, drops from the roofs of caverns, and in this mixture the bones of animals washed in by rivers are often entombed. In this manner we may account for those bony breccias which we often find in caves, some of which are of high antiquity while others are very recent and in daily progress. In no district are engulfed streams more conspicuous than in the Morea, where the phenomena attending them have been lately studied and described in great detail by M. Boblaye and his fellow-laborers of the French expedition to Greece.1045 Their account is peculiarly interesting to geologists, because it throws light on the red osseous breccias containing the bones of extinct quadrupeds which are so common in almost all the countries bordering the Mediterranean. It appears that the numerous caverns of the Morea occur in a compact limestone, of the age of the English chalk, immediately below which are arenaceous strata referred to the period of our greensand. In the more elevated districts of that peninsula there are many deep land-locked valleys, or basins, closed round on all sides by mountains of fissured and cavernous limestone. The year is divided almost as distinctly as between the tropics into a rainy season, which lasts upwards of four months, and a season of drought of nearly eight months' duration. When the torrents are swollen by the rains, they rush from surrounding heights into the inclosed basins; but, instead of giving rise to lakes, as would be the case in most other countries, they are received into gulfs or chasms, called by the Greeks "Katavothra," and which correspond to what are termed "swallow-holes" in the north of England. The water of these torrents is charged with pebbles and red ochreous earth, resembling precisely the well-known cement of the osseous breccias of the Mediterranean. It dissolves in acids with effervescence, and leaves a residue of hydrated oxide of iron, granular iron, impalpable grains of silex, and small crystals of quartz. Soil of the same description abounds everywhere on the surface of the decomposing limestone in Greece, that rock containing in it much siliceous and ferruginous matter.

Morea.—Nothing is more common in limestone areas than the disappearance of rivers, which, after flowing underground for several miles, re-emerge through a new opening. Since they usually carry fine sediment, and often sand and pebbles at their entry points, while they tend to be clear and pure when they flow out again, they must deposit a significant amount of material in the empty spaces within the earth. Besides these materials, stalagmite, or calcium carbonate, drips from the roofs of caves, and in this mixture, the bones of animals brought in by rivers are often buried. This explains the bony breccias commonly found in caves, some of which are ancient, while others are quite recent and continually forming. No region showcases swallowed streams more prominently than in the Morea, where the phenomena surrounding them have recently been studied and described in detail by M. Boblaye and his colleagues from the French expedition to Greece.1045 Their findings are particularly interesting to geologists because they shed light on the red bony breccias containing extinct quadruped bones, which are prevalent in nearly all the Mediterranean bordering countries. It seems that the numerous caves in the Morea are found in solid limestone, dating back to the era of the English chalk, beneath which are sandy layers from the greensand period. In the higher regions of the peninsula, there are many deep, landlocked valleys or basins, completely surrounded by mountains of cracked and cavernous limestone. The year is distinctly divided, almost like it is between the tropics, into a rainy season lasting over four months, and a dry season lasting nearly eight months. When the torrents swell due to the rain, they rush down from the surrounding heights into the enclosed basins; however, rather than forming lakes, as would happen in most other countries, they are funneled into gulfs or chasms called "Katavothra" by the Greeks, which correspond to what are referred to as "swallow-holes" in northern England. The water from these torrents is filled with pebbles and reddish earthy material, resembling the well-known cement found in the bony breccias of the Mediterranean. It reacts with acids, bubbling up and leaving behind hydrated iron oxide, granular iron, fine particles of silica, and small quartz crystals. The same type of soil is widespread on the surface of the decomposing limestone in Greece, which contains a lot of siliceous and ferruginous material.

Many of the Katavothra being insufficient to give passage to all the water in the rainy season, a temporary lake is formed round the mouth of the chasm, which then becomes still farther obstructed by pebbles, sand, and red mud, thrown down from the turbid waters. The lake being thus raised, its waters generally escape through other openings, at higher levels, around the borders of the plain, constituting the bottom of the closed basin.

Many of the Katavothra aren't big enough to handle all the water during the rainy season, so a temporary lake forms around the mouth of the chasm, which then gets even more blocked by pebbles, sand, and red mud from the muddy waters. As the lake fills up, its waters usually flow out through other openings at higher levels around the edges of the plain, making up the bottom of the closed basin.

In some places, as at Kavaros and Tripolitza, where the principal discharge is by a gulf in the middle of the plain, nothing can be seen over the opening in summer, when the lake dries up, but a deposit of red 735 mud, cracked in all directions. But the Katavothron is more commonly situated at the foot of the surrounding escarpment of limestone; and in that case there is sometimes room enough to allow a person to enter, in summer, and even to penetrate far into the interior. Within is seen a suite of chambers, communicating with each other by narrow passages; and M. Virlet relates, that in one instance he observed, near the entrance, human bones imbedded in recent red mud, mingled with the remains of plants and animals of species now inhabiting the Morea. It is not wonderful, he says, that the bones of man should be met with in such receptacles; for so murderous have been the late wars in Greece, that skeletons are often seen lying exposed on the surface of the country.1046

In some areas, like Kavaros and Tripolitza, where the main outflow is through a gulf in the center of the plain, nothing is visible over the opening in summer when the lake dries up, except for a layer of red mud that's cracked in all directions. However, the Katavothron is usually located at the base of the surrounding limestone cliffs; in that case, there's sometimes enough space for a person to enter during the summer and even go deep inside. Inside, there’s a series of chambers connected by narrow passages; and M. Virlet mentions that in one case he saw human bones embedded in fresh red mud near the entrance, mixed with remains of plants and animals that currently inhabit the Morea. He notes that it's not surprising to find human bones in such places; the recent wars in Greece have been so violent that skeletons are often seen lying exposed on the ground.7351046

In summer, when no water is flowing into the Katavothron, its mouth, half closed up with red mud, is masked by a vigorous vegetation, which is cherished by the moisture of the place. It is then the favorite hiding-place and den of foxes and jackals; so that the same cavity serves at one season of the year for the habitation of carnivorous beasts, and at another as the channel of an engulfed river. Near the mouth of one chasm, M. Boblaye and his companions saw the carcass of a horse, in part devoured, the size of which seemed to have prevented the jackals from dragging it in: the marks of their teeth were observed on the bones, and it was evident that the floods of the ensuing winter would wash in whatsoever might remain of the skeleton.

In summer, when no water is flowing into the Katavothron, its mouth, partially blocked with red mud, is covered by lush vegetation, thriving on the moisture in the area. It becomes a popular hiding spot and den for foxes and jackals; so the same hole serves as a home for carnivorous animals during one season and as the channel of a hidden river at another. Near the entrance of one chasm, M. Boblaye and his companions saw the carcass of a horse, partly eaten, which was too large for the jackals to drag inside: there were bite marks on the bones, and it was clear that the floods of the coming winter would wash away whatever remained of the skeleton.

It has been stated that the waters of all these torrents of the Morea are turbid where they are engulfed; but when they come out again, often at the distance of many leagues, they are perfectly clear and limpid, being only charged occasionally with a slight quantity of calcareous sand. The points of efflux are usually near the sea-shores of the Morea, but sometimes they are submarine; and when this is the case, the sands are seen to boil up for a considerable space, and the surface of the sea, in calm weather, swells in large convex waves. It is curious to reflect, that when this discharge fails in seasons of drought, the pressure of the sea may force its salt waters into subterraneous caverns, and carry in marine sand and shells, to be mingled with ossiferous mud, and the remains of terrestrial animals.

It's been said that the waters of all these torrents in the Morea are muddy where they flow underground; but when they emerge again, often many leagues away, they are perfectly clear and fresh, occasionally carrying a small amount of calcareous sand. The points where they come out are usually close to the coast of the Morea, but sometimes they are underwater; when that happens, the sands can be seen bubbling up for a significant distance, and the surface of the sea, on calm days, rises into large rounded waves. It's interesting to note that when this outflow stops during dry seasons, the pressure from the sea may force its saltwater into underground caves, bringing in marine sand and shells to mix with fossil-rich mud and remains of land animals.

In general, however, the efflux of water at these inferior openings is surprisingly uniform. It seems, therefore, that the large caverns in the interior must serve as reservoirs, and that the water escapes gradually from them, in consequence of the smallness of the rents and passages by which they communicate with the surface.

In general, though, the flow of water from these lower openings is surprisingly consistent. It seems, then, that the large caves inside must act as reservoirs, and that the water escapes slowly from them because of the small size of the cracks and passages that connect them to the surface.

The phenomena above described are not confined to the Morea, but occur in Greece generally, and in those parts of Italy, Spain, Asia Minor, and Syria, where the formations of the Morea extend. The Copaic lake in Bœotia has no outlet, except by underground channels; and hence we can explain those traditional and historical accounts of its having gained on the surrounding plains and overflowed towns, as such floods 736 must have happened whenever the outlet was partially choked up by mud, gravel, or the subsidence of rocks, caused by earthquakes. When speaking of the numerous fissures in the limestone of Greece, M. Boblaye reminds us of the famous earthquake of 469 B. C., when, as we learn from Cicero, Plutarch, Strabo, and Pliny, Sparta was laid in ruins, part of the summit of Mount Taygetus torn off, and numerous gulfs and fissures caused in the rocks of Laconia.

The phenomena described above are not limited to the Morea; they occur throughout Greece and in parts of Italy, Spain, Asia Minor, and Syria, where the formations of the Morea extend. The Copaic Lake in Bœotia has no outlet except through underground channels. This helps explain the traditional and historical accounts of it expanding onto the surrounding plains and flooding towns, as such floods must have happened whenever the outlet was partially blocked by mud, gravel, or rock subsidence caused by earthquakes. When discussing the numerous fissures in the limestone of Greece, M. Boblaye recalls the famous earthquake of 469 B.C., during which, as we learn from Cicero, Plutarch, Strabo, and Pliny, Sparta was devastated, part of the summit of Mount Taygetus was torn away, and many gulfs and fissures were created in the rocks of Laconia.

During the great earthquake of 1693, in Sicily, several thousand people were at once entombed in the ruins of caverns in limestone, at Sortino Vecchio; and, at the same time, a large stream, which had issued for ages from one of the grottoes below that town, changed suddenly its subterranean course, and came out from the mouth of a cave lower down the valley, where no water had previously flowed. To this new point the ancient water-mills were transferred, as I learnt when I visited the spot in 1829.

During the great earthquake of 1693 in Sicily, several thousand people were suddenly trapped in the ruins of limestone caves in Sortino Vecchio. At the same time, a large stream that had been flowing for centuries from one of the caves under the town suddenly changed its underground path and emerged from the mouth of a cave further down the valley, where there had previously been no water. The old water mills were moved to this new location, as I learned when I visited the site in 1829.

When the courses of engulfed rivers are thus liable to change, from time to time, by alterations in the levels of a country, and by the rending and shattering of mountain masses, we must suppose that the dens of wild beasts will sometimes be inundated by subterranean floods, and their carcasses buried under heaps of alluvium. The bones, moreover, of individuals which have died in the recesses of caves, or of animals which have been carried in for prey, may be drifted along, and mixed up with mud, sand, and fragments of rocks, so as to form osseous breccias.

When the paths of rivers can change due to shifts in the land or the breaking apart of mountains, it's likely that the dens of wild animals get flooded by underground water and their remains end up buried under layers of sediment. Additionally, the bones of animals that have died inside caves or those that were brought in as prey may be washed away and mixed with mud, sand, and rock pieces, creating bone breccias.

In 1833 I had an opportunity of examining the celebrated caves of Franconia, and among others that of Rabenstein, newly discovered. Their general form, and the nature and arrangement of their contents, appeared to me to agree perfectly with the notion of their having once served as the channels of subterranean rivers. This mode of accounting for the introduction of transported matter into the Franconian and other caves, filled up as they often are even to their roofs with osseous breccia, was long ago proposed by M. C. Prevost,1047 and seems at length to be very generally adopted. But I do not doubt that bears inhabited some of the German caves, or that the cavern of Kirkdale, in Yorkshire, was once the den of hyænas. The abundance of bony dung, associated with hyænas' bones, has been pointed out by Dr. Buckland, and with reason, as confirmatory of this opinion.

In 1833, I had the chance to explore the famous caves of Franconia, including the newly discovered Rabenstein Cave. Their overall shape and the way their contents were arranged seemed to fit perfectly with the idea that they once acted as channels for underground rivers. This explanation for how transported materials ended up in the Franconian and other caves—often filled to the ceiling with bone debris—was suggested long ago by M. C. Prevost,1047 and it now seems to be widely accepted. However, I’m sure that bears lived in some of the German caves, and that the Kirkdale Cave in Yorkshire was once a den for hyenas. The large amount of bone deposits mixed with hyena bones has been noted by Dr. Buckland and is rightly seen as evidence supporting this view.

The same author observed in every cave examined by him in Germany, that deposits of mud and sand, with or without rolled pebbles and angular fragments of rock, were covered over with a single crust of stalagmite.1048 In the English caves he remarked a similar absence of alterations of alluvium and stalagmite. But Dr. Schmerling has discovered in a cavern at Chockier, about two leagues from Liège, three distinct beds of stalagmite, and between each of them a mass of breccia, and mud mixed with quartz pebbles, and in the three deposits the bones of extinct quadrupeds.1049

The same author noted in every cave he examined in Germany that layers of mud and sand, with or without rounded pebbles and jagged rock fragments, were topped with a single layer of stalagmite.1048 In the English caves, he found a similar lack of changes in the alluvium and stalagmite. However, Dr. Schmerling discovered three distinct layers of stalagmite in a cave at Chockier, about two leagues from Liège, with a layer of breccia and mud mixed with quartz pebbles between each one, and in all three layers, the bones of extinct mammals.1049

737 This exception does not invalidate the generality of the phenomenon pointed out by Dr. Buckland, one cause of which may perhaps be this, that if several floods pass at different intervals of time through a subterranean passage, the last, if it has power to drift along fragments of rock, will also tear up any alternating stalagmitic and alluvial beds that may have been previously formed. Another cause may be, that a particular line of caverns will rarely be so situated, in relation to the lowest levels of a country, as to become, at two distinct epochs, the receptacle of engulfed rivers; and if this should happen, some of the caves, or at least the tunnels of communication, may at the first period be entirely choked up with transported matter, so as not to allow the subsequent passage of water in the same direction.

737 This exception doesn’t undermine the general idea pointed out by Dr. Buckland. One reason for this might be that if several floods occur at different times through an underground passage, the last one, if it’s strong enough to carry away rock fragments, will also remove any alternating stalagmite and alluvial layers that may have formed before. Another reason could be that a particular system of caves usually isn’t positioned in a way that allows it to collect flooded rivers at two separate times. If this does happen, some of the caves, or at least the connecting tunnels, could be completely blocked with debris from the first event, preventing water from flowing in the same direction later on.

As the same chasms may remain open throughout periods of indefinite duration, the species inhabiting a country may in the meantime be greatly changed, and thus the remains of animals belonging to very different epochs may become mingled together in a common tomb. For this reason it is often difficult to separate the monuments of the human epoch from those relating to periods long antecedent, and it was not without great care and skill that Dr. Buckland was enabled to guard against such anachronisms in his investigations of several of the English caves. He mentions that human skeletons were found in the cave of Wokey Hole, near Wells, in the Mendips, dispersed through reddish mud and clay, and some of them united by stalagmite into a firm osseous breccia. "The spot on which they lie is within reach of the highest floods of the adjacent river, and the mud in which they are buried is evidently fluviatile."1050

As the same gaps can stay open for an extended time, the species living in a country may change significantly during that time, causing the remains of animals from very different periods to become mixed together in one common burial site. Because of this, it can be challenging to distinguish artifacts from the human era from those dating back long before. Dr. Buckland took great care and skill to avoid such mix-ups in his studies of various English caves. He notes that human skeletons were discovered in the Wokey Hole cave, near Wells in the Mendips, scattered through reddish mud and clay, with some of them bonded by stalagmite into a solid bone breccia. "The location where they are found is within reach of the highest floods from the nearby river, and the mud they are buried in is clearly river sediment."1050

In speaking of the cave of Paviland on the coast of Glamorganshire the same author states that the entire mass through which bones were dispersed appeared to have been disturbed by ancient diggings, so that the remains of extinct animals had become mixed with recent bones and shells. In the same cave was a human skeleton, and the remains of recent testacea of eatable species, which may have been carried in by man.

In talking about the cave of Paviland on the Glamorganshire coast, the same author notes that the whole area where the bones were scattered seemed to have been disturbed by ancient excavations, causing the remains of extinct animals to mix with more recent bones and shells. In that same cave, there was a human skeleton and remains of recent edible shellfish, which may have been brought in by people.

In several caverns on the banks of the Meuse, near Liège, Dr. Schmerling has found human bones in the same mud and breccia with those of the elephant, rhinoceros, bear, and other quadrupeds of extinct species. He has observed none of the dung of any of these animals: and from this circumstance, and the appearance of the mud and pebbles, he concludes that these caverns were never inhabited by wild beasts, but washed in by a current of water. As the human skulls and bones were in fragments, and no entire skeleton had been found, he does not believe that these caves were places of sepulture, but that the human remains were washed in at the same time as the bones of extinct quadrupeds, and that these lost species of mammalia co-existed on the earth with man.

In several caves along the Meuse River, near Liège, Dr. Schmerling has discovered human bones mixed in the same mud and debris as those of the elephant, rhinoceros, bear, and other extinct animals. He hasn’t found any dung from these animals, and based on this, along with the look of the mud and pebbles, he concludes that these caves were never home to wild beasts but were filled with water currents. Since the human skulls and bones were broken into pieces and no complete skeletons were found, he doesn’t think these caves were burial sites. Instead, he believes the human remains were washed in at the same time as the bones of extinct quadrupeds, suggesting that these extinct mammal species co-existed with humans on earth.

Caverns in the south of France.—Similar associations in the south of France, of human bones and works of art, with remains of extinct quadrupeds, have induced other geologists to maintain that man was an 738 inhabitant of that part of Europe before the rhinoceros, hyæna, tiger, and many fossil species disappeared. I may first mention the cavern of Bize, in the department of Aude, where M. Marcel de Serres met with a small number of human bones mixed with those of extinct animals and with land shells. They occur in a calcareous stony mass, bound together by a cement of stalagmite. On examining the same caverns, M. Tournal found not only in these calcareous beds, but also in a black mud which overlies a red osseous mud, several human teeth, together with broken angular fragments of a rude kind of pottery, and also recent marine and terrestrial shells. The teeth preserve their enamel; but the fangs are so much altered as to adhere strongly when applied to the tongue. Of the terrestrial shells thus associated with the bones and pottery, the most common are Cyclostoma elegans, Bulimus decollatus, Helix nemoralis, and H. nitida. Among the marine are found Pecten jacobæus, Mytilus edulis, and Natica mille-punctata, all of them eatable kinds, and which may have been brought there for food. Bones were found in the same mass belonging to three new species of deer, the brown bear (Ursus arctoïdeus), and the wild bull (Bos urus), formerly a native of Germany.1051

Caverns in the south of France.—Similar connections in the south of France, where human bones and artworks are found alongside remains of extinct mammals, have led other geologists to argue that humans lived in that part of Europe before the rhinoceros, hyena, tiger, and many fossil species went extinct. First, I should mention the cave at Bize, in the Aude department, where M. Marcel de Serres discovered a few human bones mixed with those of extinct animals and land shells. They are embedded in a calcareous stone mass held together by stalagmite cement. While examining the same caves, M. Tournal found not only in these calcareous layers but also in a black mud that lies above a red bone mud, several human teeth, along with broken pieces of a rough kind of pottery, and recent marine and terrestrial shells. The teeth still have their enamel; however, the roots are altered enough that they grip strongly when pressed to the tongue. Of the terrestrial shells found alongside the bones and pottery, the most common are Cyclostoma elegans, Bulimus decollatus, Helix nemoralis, and H. nitida. Among the marine shells are Pecten jacobæus, Mytilus edulis, and Natica mille-punctata, all edible types that may have been brought there for food. Bones belonging to three new species of deer, the brown bear (Ursus arctoïdeus), and the wild bull (Bos urus), which once lived in Germany, were also found in the same mass.1051

In the same parts of France, M. de Christol has found in caverns in a tertiary limestone at Pondres and Souvignargues, two leagues north of Lunel-viel, in the department of Herault, human bones and pottery confusedly mixed with remains of the rhinoceros, bear, hyæna, and other terrestrial mammifers. They were imbedded in alluvial mud, of the solidity of calcareous tufa, and containing some flint pebbles and fragments of the limestone of the country. Beneath this mixed accumulation, which sometimes attained a thickness of thirteen feet, is the original floor of the cavern, about a foot thick, covered with bones and the dung of animals (album græcum), in a sandy and tufaceous cement.

In the same regions of France, M. de Christol discovered human bones and pottery mixed with remains of rhinoceros, bear, hyena, and other land mammals in caves located in tertiary limestone at Pondres and Souvignargues, two leagues north of Lunel-viel, in the department of Hérault. These finds were embedded in alluvial mud, as solid as calcareous tufa, and included some flint pebbles and fragments of local limestone. Underneath this mixed accumulation, which sometimes reached a thickness of thirteen feet, lies the original floor of the cave, about one foot thick, covered with bones and animal dung (album græcum), in a sandy and tufaceous cement.

The human bones in these caverns of Pondres and Souvignargues were found, upon a careful analysis, to have parted with their animal matter to as great a degree as those of the hyæna which accompany them, and are equally brittle, and adhere as strongly to the tongue.

The human bones in the caves of Pondres and Souvignargues were found, after careful analysis, to have lost their organic material to the same extent as those of the hyena that are found alongside them. They are just as brittle and stick to the tongue in the same way.

In order to compare the degree of alteration of these bones with those known to be of high antiquity, M. Marcel de Serres and M. Ballard, chemists of Montpelier, procured some from a Gaulish sarcophagus, in the plain of Lunel, supposed to have been buried for fourteen or fifteen centuries at least. In these the cellular tissue was empty, but they were more solid than fresh bones. They did not adhere to the tongue in the same manner as those of the caverns of Bize and Pondres, yet they had lost at least three fourths of their original animal matter.

To compare how much these bones have changed with others known to be very old, M. Marcel de Serres and M. Ballard, chemists from Montpellier, obtained some from a Gaulish sarcophagus in the plain of Lunel, which is thought to have been buried for at least fourteen or fifteen centuries. In these bones, the cellular tissue was empty, but they were denser than fresh bones. They didn’t stick to the tongue like those from the caves of Bize and Pondres, yet they had lost at least three-quarters of their original organic material.

The superior solidity of the Gaulish bones to those in a fresh skeleton is a fact in perfect accordance with the observations made by Dr. Mantell on bones taken from a Saxon tumulus near Lewes.

The greater strength of Gallic bones compared to those in a fresh skeleton is completely consistent with the findings of Dr. Mantell on bones extracted from a Saxon burial mound near Lewes.

M. Tessier has also described a cavern near Mialet, in the department 739 of Gard, where the remains of the bear and other animals were mingled confusedly with human bones, coarse pottery, teeth pierced for amulets, pointed fragments of bone, bracelets of bronze, and a Roman urn. Part of this deposit reached to the roof of the cavity, and adhered firmly to it. The author suggests that the exterior portion of the grotto may at one period have been a den of bears, and that afterwards the aboriginal inhabitants of the country took possession of it either for a dwelling or a burial-place, and left there the coarse pottery, amulets, and pointed pieces of bone. At a third period the Romans may have used the cavern as a place of sepulture or concealment, and to them may have belonged the urn and bracelets of metal. If we then suppose the course of the neighboring river to be impeded by some temporary cause, a flood would be occasioned, which, rushing into the open grotto, may have washed all the remains into the interior caves and tunnels, heaping the whole confusedly together.1052

M. Tessier also described a cave near Mialet, in the Gard department, where the remains of bears and other animals were mixed up with human bones, rough pottery, teeth made into amulets, sharp bits of bone, bronze bracelets, and a Roman urn. Some of this material reached all the way to the cave's roof and stuck to it firmly. The author suggests that the outside part of the cave may have once been a bear den, which was later occupied by the native people of the area for either living or burial purposes, leaving behind the rough pottery, amulets, and sharp bone pieces. Later on, the Romans might have used the cave for burial or hiding, possibly leaving behind the urn and metal bracelets. If we assume that the nearby river was blocked by some temporary event, a flood could have rushed into the open cave, washing all the remains into the inner caves and tunnels, mixing everything together in a chaotic pile.739

In the controversy which has arisen on this subject, MM. Marcel de Serres, De Christol, Tournal, and others, have contended, that the phenomena of this and other caverns in the south of France prove that the fossil rhinoceros, hyæna, bear, and several other lost species, were once contemporaneous inhabitants of the country, together with man; while M. Desnoyers has supported the opposite opinion. The flint hatchets and arrow-heads, he says, and the pointed bones and coarse pottery of many French and English caves, agree precisely in character with those found in the tumuli, and under the dolmens (rude altars of unhewn stone) of the primitive inhabitants of Gaul, Britain, and Germany. The human bones, therefore, in the caves which are associated with such fabricated objects, must belong not to antediluvian periods, but to a people in the same stage of civilization as those who constructed the tumuli and altars.

In the debate that has come up on this topic, Marcel de Serres, De Christol, Tournal, and others argue that the findings in this and other caves in southern France show that the fossilized rhinoceros, hyena, bear, and several other extinct species coexisted with humans in the area. Meanwhile, Desnoyers has a different view. He points out that the flint tools and arrowheads, along with pointed bones and rough pottery discovered in many caves in France and England, match exactly with those found in the burial mounds and dolmens (simple stone altars) of the early inhabitants of Gaul, Britain, and Germany. Therefore, the human bones found in the caves alongside these crafted items must belong not to prehistoric times, but to a group of people at a similar level of civilization as those who built the burial mounds and altars.

In the Gaulish monuments we find, together with the objects of industry above mentioned, the bones of wild and domestic animals of species now inhabiting Europe, particularly of deer, sheep, wild-boars, dogs, horses, and oxen. This fact has been ascertained in Quercy, and other provinces; and it is supposed by antiquaries that the animals in question were placed beneath the Celtic altars in memory of sacrifices offered to the Gaulish divinity Hesus, and in the tombs to commemorate funeral repasts, and also from a supposition prevalent among savage nations, which induces them to lay up provisions for the manes of the dead in a future life. But in none of these ancient monuments have any bones been found of the elephant, rhinoceros, hyæna, tiger, and other quadrupeds, such as are found in caves, as might certainly have been expected had these species continued to flourish at the time that this part of Gaul was inhabited by man.1053

In the Gaulish monuments, alongside the previously mentioned tools, we find the bones of wild and domestic animals that still live in Europe today, especially deer, sheep, wild boars, dogs, horses, and oxen. This has been confirmed in Quercy and other regions; antiquarians believe these animals were placed under Celtic altars to remember sacrifices made to the Gaulish god Hesus, in tombs to honor funeral banquets, and also based on a belief among primitive cultures that they should stockpile provisions for the spirits of the dead in the afterlife. However, none of these ancient sites have yielded bones of elephants, rhinoceroses, hyenas, tigers, or other mammals typically found in caves, which would have been expected if these species had still been thriving when this area of Gaul was inhabited by people.1053

We are also reminded by M. Desnoyers of a passage in Florus, in which it is related that Cæsar ordered the caves into which the Aquitanian 740 Gauls had retreated to be closed up.1054 It is also on record, that so late as the eighth century, the Aquitanians defended themselves in caverns against King Pepin. As many of these caverns, therefore, may have served in succession as temples and habitations, as places of sepulture, concealment, or defence, it is easy to conceive that human bones, and those of animals, in osseous breccias of much older date, may have been swept away together, by inundations, and then buried in one promiscuous heap.

We are also reminded by M. Desnoyers of a passage in Florus, which describes how Cæsar ordered the caves where the Aquitanian Gauls had taken refuge to be sealed up.7401054 It’s also noted that as late as the eighth century, the Aquitanians defended themselves in caves against King Pepin. Therefore, since many of these caves may have served over time as temples, homes, burial sites, hiding places, or defensive positions, it’s easy to imagine that human bones and those of animals, along with older fossil remains, could have been washed away together by floods and then buried in one mixed pile.

It is not on the evidence of such intermixtures that we ought readily to admit either the high antiquity of the human race, or the recent date of certain lost species of quadrupeds.

It’s not through the evidence of these mixtures that we should quickly accept either the ancient origins of humanity or the recent extinction of certain lost species of four-legged animals.

Among the various modes in which the bones of animals become preserved, independently of the agency of land floods and engulfed rivers, I may mention that open fissures often serve as natural pitfalls in which herbivorous animals perish. This may happen the more readily when they are chased by beasts of prey, or when surprised while carelessly browsing on the shrubs which so often overgrow and conceal the edges of fissures.1055

Among the different ways animal bones can be preserved, apart from being buried by floods and rivers, I should point out that open cracks often act as natural traps where herbivorous animals meet their end. This is more likely to occur when they are being chased by predators or when they are caught off guard while carelessly munching on the bushes that frequently grow over and hide the edges of these cracks.1055

During the excavations recently made near Behat in India, the bones of two deer were found at the bottom of an ancient well which had been filled up with alluvial loam. Their horns were broken to pieces, but the jaw bones and other parts of the skeleton remained tolerably perfect. "Their presence," says Captain Cautley, "is easily accounted for, as a great number of these and other animals are constantly lost in galloping over the jungles and among the high grass by falling into deserted wells."1056

During recent excavations near Behat in India, the bones of two deer were discovered at the bottom of an ancient well that had been filled with alluvial soil. Their horns were shattered, but the jawbones and other parts of the skeleton remained relatively intact. "Their presence," says Captain Cautley, "is easily explained, as many of these and other animals frequently get lost while galloping through the jungles and tall grass by falling into abandoned wells."1056

Above the village of Selside, near Ingleborough in Yorkshire, a chasm of enormous but unknown depth occurs in the scar-limestone, a member of the carboniferous series. "The chasm," says Professor Sedgwick, "is surrounded by grassy shelving banks, and many animals, tempted towards its brink, have fallen down and perished in it. The approach of cattle is now prevented by a strong lofty wall; but there can be no doubt that, during the last two or three thousand years, great masses of bony breccia must have accumulated in the lower parts of the great fissure, which probably descends through the whole thickness of the scar-limestone, to the depth of perhaps five or six hundred feet."1057

Above the village of Selside, near Ingleborough in Yorkshire, there is a deep chasm in the scar-limestone, which is part of the carboniferous series, though its exact depth is unknown. "The chasm," says Professor Sedgwick, "is surrounded by grassy sloped banks, and many animals, lured to its edge, have fallen in and died. A tall, sturdy wall now prevents cattle from approaching it; however, there’s no doubt that over the last two or three thousand years, large amounts of bony breccia have built up in the lower sections of this great fissure, which likely extends down through the entire thickness of the scar-limestone, reaching depths of around five or six hundred feet." 1057

When any of these natural pit-falls happen to communicate with lines of subterranean caverns, the bones, earth, and breccia, may sink by their own weight, or be washed into the vaults below.

When any of these natural sinkholes connect with lines of underground caves, the bones, soil, and debris may collapse under their own weight or be washed into the chambers below.

At the north extremity of the rock of Gibraltar are perpendicular fissures, on the ledges of which a number of hawks nestle and rear their young in the breeding season. They throw down from their nests the bones of small birds, mice, and other animals, on which they feed, and 741 these are gradually united into a breccia of angular fragments of the decomposing limestone with a cement of red earth.

At the northern tip of the rock of Gibraltar, there are vertical cracks where several hawks build their nests and raise their chicks during the breeding season. They toss out the bones of small birds, mice, and other animals that they eat, and 741 these gradually combine into a breccia made of jagged pieces of the crumbling limestone, held together by red clay.

At the pass of Escrinet in France, on the northern escarpment of the Coiron hills, near Aubenas, I have seen a breccia in the act of forming. Small pieces of disintegrating limestone are transported, during heavy rains, by a streamlet, to the foot of the declivity, where land shells are very abundant. The shells and pieces of stone soon become cemented together by stalagmite into a compact mass, and the talus thus formed is in one place fifty feet deep, and five hundred yards wide. So firmly is the lowest portion consolidated, that it is quarried for mill-stones.

At the Escrinet pass in France, on the northern slope of the Coiron hills, near Aubenas, I’ve seen breccia forming. During heavy rains, small pieces of crumbling limestone get carried by a stream down to the foot of the slope, where land shells are quite plentiful. The shells and bits of stone quickly get cemented together by stalagmite into a solid mass, and the debris pile that forms is fifty feet deep in some spots and five hundred yards wide. The lowest part is so strongly compacted that it’s quarried for millstones.

Recent, stalagmitic limestone of Cuba.—One of the most singular examples of the recent growth of stalagmitic limestone in caves and fissures is that described by Mr. R. C. Taylor, as observable on the north-east part of the island of Cuba.1058 The country there is composed of a white marble, in which are numerous cavities, partially filled with a calcareous deposit of a brick-red color. In this red deposit are shells, or often the hollow casts of shells, chiefly referable to eight or nine species of land snails, a few scattered bones of quadrupeds, and, what is still more singular, marine univalve shells, often at the height of many hundred, or even one thousand feet above the sea. The following explanation is given of the gradual increase of this deposit. Land snails of the genera Helix, Cyclostoma, Pupa, and Clausilia, retire into the caves, the floors of which are strewed with myriads of their dead and unoccupied shells, at the same time that water infiltered through the mountain throws down carbonate of lime, enveloping the shells, together with fragments of the white limestone which occasionally falls from the roof. Multitudes of bats resort to the caves; and their dung, which is of a bright red color, (probably derived from the berries on which they feed,) imparts its red hue to the mass. Sometimes also the Hutia, or great Indian rat of the island, dies and leaves its bones in the caves. "At certain seasons the soldier-crabs resort to the sea-shore, and then return from their pilgrimage, each carrying with them, or rather dragging, the shell of some marine univalve for many a weary mile. They may be traced even at the distance of eight or ten miles from the shore, on the summit of mountains 1200 feet high, like the pilgrims of the olden times, each bearing his shell to denote the character and extent of his wanderings." By this means several species of marine testacea of the genera Trochus, Turbo, Littorina, and Monodonta, are conveyed into inland caverns, and enter into the composition of the newly formed rock.

Recent, stalagmitic limestone of Cuba.—One of the most unique examples of the recent formation of stalagmitic limestone in caves and crevices is detailed by Mr. R. C. Taylor, found in the northeast part of the island of Cuba.1058 The area consists of a white marble, featuring numerous cavities that are partially filled with a brick-red calcareous deposit. Within this red deposit, there are shells, or often the hollow casts of shells, primarily belonging to eight or nine species of land snails, a few scattered bones of quadrupeds, and notably, marine univalve shells that can be found several hundred, or even one thousand feet above sea level. The process by which this deposit gradually accumulates is explained as follows: Land snails from the genera Helix, Cyclostoma, Pupa, and Clausilia retreat into the caves, where the floors are covered with countless dead and unoccupied shells. At the same time, water filtering through the mountains deposits carbonate of lime, covering the shells along with fragments of the white limestone that occasionally fall from the ceiling. Numerous bats frequent the caves, and their bright red dung, likely from the berries they consume, contributes to the red hue of the mass. Occasionally, the Hutia, or large Indian rat of the island, dies and leaves its bones in the caves. "At certain times, soldier crabs come to the seashore, and then return from their trek, each carrying or rather dragging a marine univalve shell for many miles. They can be followed even eight or ten miles from the shore, up to mountain tops 1200 feet high, much like ancient pilgrims, each bearing their shell to indicate the nature and extent of their travels." Through this process, several species of marine testacea from the genera Trochus, Turbo, Littorina, and Monodonta are brought into inland caves and become part of the newly formed rock.


CHAPTER XLVII.

IMBEDDING OF ORGANIC REMAINS IN SUBAQUEOUS DEPOSITS.

Division of the subject—Imbedding of terrestrial animals and plants—Increased specific gravity of wood sunk to great depths in the sea—Drift-timber of the Mackenzie in Slave Lake and Polar Sea—Floating trees in the Mississippi—in the Gulf Stream—on the coast of Iceland, Spitzbergen, and Labrador—Submarine forests—Example on coast of Hampshire—Mineralization of plants—Imbedding of marine plants—of insects—of reptiles—Bones of birds why rare—Imbedding of terrestrial quadrupeds by river floods—Skeletons in recent shell marl—Imbedding of mammiferous remains in marine strata.

Division of the topic—Burial of land animals and plants—Increased density of wood that has sunk to great depths in the ocean—Driftwood from the Mackenzie River found in Slave Lake and the Polar Sea—Floating trees in the Mississippi—in the Gulf Stream—along the coasts of Iceland, Spitsbergen, and Labrador—Underwater forests—Example on the Hampshire coast—Mineralization of plants—Burial of marine plants—of insects—of reptiles—Why bird bones are rare—Burial of land mammals by river floods—Skeletons in recent shell marl—Burial of mammal remains in marine layers.

Division of the subject.—Having treated of the imbedding of organic remains in deposits formed upon the land, I shall next consider the including of the same in deposits formed under water.

Division of the subject.—Having discussed the embedding of organic remains in deposits formed on land, I will now consider their inclusion in deposits formed underwater.

It will be convenient to divide this branch of our subject into three parts; considering, first, the various modes whereby the relics of terrestrial species may be buried in subaqueous formations; secondly, the modes whereby animals and plants inhabiting fresh water may be so entombed; thirdly, how marine species may become preserved in new strata.

It will be useful to break this part of our topic into three sections: first, looking at the different ways that remains of land species can be buried in underwater formations; second, examining how animals and plants living in fresh water can be buried; and third, exploring how ocean species can be preserved in new layers.

The phenomena above enumerated demand a fuller share of attention than those previously examined, since the deposits which originate upon dry land are insignificant in thickness, superficial extent, and durability, when contrasted with those of subaqueous origin. At the same time, the study of the latter is beset with greater difficulties; for we are here concerned with the results of processes much farther removed from the sphere of ordinary observation. There is, indeed, no circumstance which so seriously impedes the acquisition of just views in our science as an habitual disregard of the important fact, that the reproductive effects of the principal agents of change are confined to another element—to that larger portion of the globe, from which by our very organization we are almost entirely excluded.1059

The phenomena mentioned above require more attention than those discussed earlier, as the deposits formed on dry land are minimal in thickness, size, and durability compared to those formed underwater. At the same time, studying the latter is more challenging because it involves processes that are much harder to observe directly. In fact, nothing hinders our understanding in this field more than a consistent neglect of the crucial fact that the reproductive effects of the main agents of change are limited to a different environment—specifically, that larger portion of the Earth from which, due to our very nature, we are almost completely excluded.1059

Imbedding of Terrestrial Plants.

When a tree falls into a river from the undermining of the banks or from being washed in by a torrent or flood, it floats on the surface, not because the woody portion is specifically lighter than water, but because it is full of pores containing air. When soaked for a considerable time, the water makes its way into these pores, and the wood becomes waterlogged and sinks. The time required for this process varies in different woods; but several kinds may be drifted to great distances, sometimes across the ocean, before they lose their buoyancy.

When a tree falls into a river due to the banks eroding or being washed in by a flood, it floats on the surface not because the wood is lighter than water, but because it’s full of air-filled pores. After being soaked for a long time, water seeps into these pores, causing the wood to become waterlogged and sink. The time this takes varies for different types of wood, but some can drift for long distances, even across the ocean, before they lose their ability to float.

743 Wood sunk to a great depth in the sea.—If wood be sunk to vast depths in the sea, it may be impregnated with water suddenly. Captain Scoresby informs us, in his Account of the Arctic Regions, that on one occasion a whale, on being harpooned, ran out all the lines in the boat, which it then dragged under water, to the depth of several thousand feet, the men having just time to escape to a piece of ice. When the fish returned to the surface "to blow," it was struck a second time, and soon afterwards killed. The moment it expired it began to sink,—an unusual circumstance, which was found to be caused by the weight of the sunken boat, which still remained attached to it. By means of harpoons and ropes the fish was prevented from sinking, until it was released from the weight by connecting a rope to the lines of the attached boat, which was no sooner done than the fish rose again to the surface. The sunken boat was then hauled up with great labor; for so heavy was it, that although before the accident it would have been buoyant when full of water, yet it now required a boat at each end to keep it from sinking. "When it was hoisted into the ship, the paint came off the wood in large sheets; and the planks, which were of wainscot, were as completely soaked in every pore as if they had lain at the bottom of the sea since the flood! A wooden apparatus that accompanied the boat in its progress through the deep, consisting chiefly of a piece of thick deal, about fifteen inches square, happened to fall overboard, and, though it originally consisted of the lightest fir, sank in the water like a stone. The boat was rendered useless; even the wood of which it was built, on being offered to the cook for fuel, was tried and rejected as incombustible."1060

743 Wood sunk to a great depth in the sea.—If wood is submerged to great depths in the ocean, it can quickly absorb water. Captain Scoresby tells us in his Account of the Arctic Regions that once, when a whale was harpooned, it pulled all the lines from the boat and dragged it underwater to depths of several thousand feet, leaving the crew just enough time to escape to a piece of ice. When the whale came back to the surface to exhale, it was struck again and soon killed. As soon as it died, it began to sink—an unusual occurrence caused by the weight of the submerged boat still attached to it. Using harpoons and ropes, they managed to keep the whale from sinking until they connected a rope to the lines of the attached boat. The moment they did that, the whale floated back to the surface. They then struggled to haul the sunken boat back up; it was so heavy that, although it would have floated when full of water, it now needed a boat on each end to prevent it from sinking. "When it was lifted onto the ship, large sheets of paint peeled off the wood; and the planks, made of wainscot, were completely soaked through as if they had been lying at the bottom of the sea since the flood! A wooden piece that had gone overboard with the boat, which was mainly a thick board around fifteen inches square, had originally been very light but sank in the water like a stone. The boat became unusable; even the wood it was made from, when offered to the cook for fuel, was tested and rejected as being non-flammable."1060

Captain Scoresby found that, by sinking pieces of fir, elm, ash, &c., to the depth of four thousand and sometimes six thousand feet, they became impregnated with sea-water, and when drawn up again, after immersion for an hour, would no longer float. The effect of this impregnation was to increase the dimensions as well as the specific gravity of the wood, every solid inch having increased one-twentieth in size and twenty-one twenty-fifths in weight.1061

Captain Scoresby discovered that when he sank pieces of fir, elm, ash, etc., to depths of four thousand to six thousand feet, they absorbed sea water. When these pieces were pulled up again after being underwater for an hour, they no longer floated. This absorption caused both the size and the specific gravity of the wood to increase, with each solid inch becoming one-twentieth larger and twenty-one twenty-fifths heavier.1061

Drift-wood of the Mackenzie River.—When timber is drifted down by a river, it is often arrested by lakes; and, becoming water-logged, it may sink and be imbedded in lacustrine strata, if any be there forming; sometimes a portion floats on till it reaches the sea. In the course of the Mackenzie River we have an example of vast accumulations of vegetable matter now in progress under both these circumstances.

Driftwood of the Mackenzie River.—When timber is carried down by a river, it often gets caught by lakes; and, becoming soaked with water, it may sink and become embedded in sediment layers, if those are forming. Sometimes a part remains floating until it reaches the sea. Along the Mackenzie River, we see a significant buildup of plant matter happening under both of these conditions.

In Slave Lake in particular, which vies in dimensions with some of the great fresh-water seas of Canada, the quantity of drift-timber brought down annually is enormous. "As the trees," says Dr. Richardson, "retain their roots, which are often loaded with earth and stones, they readily sink, especially when water-soaked; and, accumulating in the eddies, form shoals, which ultimately augment into islands. A thicket of small willows covers the new-formed island as soon as it appears 744 above water, and their fibrous roots serve to bind the whole firmly together. Sections of these islands are annually made by the river, assisted by the frost; and it is interesting to study the diversity of appearances they present, according to their different ages. The trunks of the trees gradually decay until they are converted into a blackish brown substance resembling peat, but which still retains more or less of the fibrous structure of the wood; and layers of this often alternate with layers of clay and sand, the whole being penetrated, to the depth of four or five yards or more, by the long fibrous roots of the willows. A deposition of this kind, with the aid of a little infiltration of bituminous matter, would produce an excellent imitation of coal, with vegetable impressions of the willow-roots. What appeared most remarkable was the horizontal slaty structure that the old alluvial banks presented, or the regular curve that the strata assumed from unequal subsidence.

In Slave Lake in particular, which competes in size with some of Canada’s large freshwater lakes, the amount of driftwood brought down each year is massive. "As the trees," says Dr. Richardson, "keep their roots, which are often packed with dirt and stones, they easily sink, especially when soaked with water; and, accumulating in the eddies, form shoals that eventually turn into islands. A thicket of small willows grows over the new island as soon as it surfaces, and their fibrous roots help hold everything together. The river, aided by the frost, creates sections of these islands every year; and it's fascinating to observe the different appearances they have based on their ages. The trunks of the trees slowly decay until they become a dark brown material similar to peat, but still partly retains the fibrous structure of wood; and layers of this often alternate with layers of clay and sand, all being penetrated, to a depth of four or five yards or more, by the long fibrous roots of the willows. Such a deposition, along with a little infiltration of bituminous material, could create an excellent imitation of coal, complete with impressions of the willow roots. What seemed most remarkable was the horizontal layered structure of the old alluvial banks, or the regular curve that the strata took on from uneven subsidence.

"It was in the rivers only that we could observe sections of these deposits; but the same operation goes on, on a much more magnificent scale, in the lakes. A shoal of many miles in extent is formed on the south side of Athabasca Lake, by the drift-timber and vegetable debris brought down by the Elk River; and the Slave Lake itself must in process of time be filled up by matters daily conveyed into it from Slave River. Vast quantities of drift-timber are buried under the sand at the mouth of the river, and enormous piles of it are accumulated on the shores of every part of the lake."1062

"It was only in the rivers that we could see parts of these deposits; however, the same process happens on a much larger scale in the lakes. A shoal stretching for many miles forms on the south side of Athabasca Lake, created by the driftwood and plant debris carried down by the Elk River. Over time, Slave Lake itself will fill up with materials that are constantly brought into it from Slave River. Huge amounts of driftwood are buried under the sand at the river's mouth, and large piles of it accumulate along the shores of every part of the lake."1062

The banks of the Mackenzie display almost everywhere horizontal beds of wood coal, alternating with bituminous clay, gravel, sand, and friable sandstone; sections, in short, of such deposits as are now evidently forming at the bottom of the lakes which it traverses.

The banks of the Mackenzie show nearly everywhere flat layers of coal, mixed with soft clay, gravel, sand, and loose sandstone; basically, these are sections of deposits that are clearly forming now at the bottom of the lakes that it flows through.

Notwithstanding the vast forests intercepted by the lakes, a still greater mass of drift-wood is found where the Mackenzie reaches the sea, in a latitude where no wood grows at present except a few stunted willows. At the mouths of the river the alluvial matter has formed a barrier of islands and shoals, where we may expect a great formation of coal at some distant period.

Despite the large forests cut off by the lakes, an even bigger amount of driftwood is found where the Mackenzie flows into the sea, in an area where no trees currently grow except for a few stunted willows. At the river's mouth, the mud has created a barrier of islands and shallow areas, where we can anticipate a significant coal formation at some point in the future.

The abundance of floating timber on the Mackenzie is owing, as Dr. Richardson informs me, to the direction and to the length of the course of this river, which runs from south to north, so that the sources of the stream lie in much warmer latitudes than its mouths. In the country, therefore, where the sources are situated, the frost breaks up at an earlier season, while yet the waters in the lower part of its course are ice-bound. Hence the current of water, rushing down northward, reaches a point where the thaw has not begun, and, finding the channel of the river blocked up with ice, it overflows the banks, sweeping through forests of pines, and carrying away thousands of uprooted trees.

The large amount of floating timber in the Mackenzie is due, as Dr. Richardson told me, to the river's direction and the length of its path, which goes from south to north, meaning that the river's source is in much warmer areas than where it flows into. In the region where the sources are located, the frost thaws earlier, while the waters in the lower part of the river are still frozen. As a result, the current of water rushing north reaches a point where the thaw hasn’t started, and since the river channel is blocked with ice, it overflows the banks, flooding through pine forests and carrying away thousands of uprooted trees.

Drift-timber on coasts of Iceland, Spitzbergen, &c.—The ancient forests of Iceland, observes Malte-Brun, have been improvidently exhausted; 745 but, although the Icelander can obtain no timber from the land, he is supplied with it abundantly by the ocean. An immense quantity of thick trunks of pines, firs, and other trees, are thrown upon the northern coast of the island, especially upon the North Cape and Cape Langaness, and are then carried by the waves along these two promontories to other parts of the coast, so as to afford sufficiency of wood for fuel and for constructing boats. Timber is also carried to the shores of Labrador and Greenland; and Crantz assures us that the masses of floating wood thrown by the waves upon the island of John de Mayen often equal the whole of that island in extent.1063

Driftwood on the coasts of Iceland, Spitzbergen, etc.—The ancient forests of Iceland, notes Malte-Brun, have been recklessly depleted; 745 but even though Icelanders have no local timber to use, they receive a plentiful supply from the ocean. A vast amount of thick trunks from pines, firs, and other trees is cast onto the northern coast of the island, especially around North Cape and Cape Langaness, and those logs are then carried by the waves along these two promontories to other parts of the coastline, providing enough wood for fuel and boat construction. Timber is also washed up on the shores of Labrador and Greenland; and Crantz tells us that the masses of floating wood that the waves deposit on the island of John de Mayen often cover an area as large as the island itself.1063

In a similar manner the bays of Spitzbergen are filled with drift-wood, which accumulates also upon those parts of the coast of Siberia that are exposed to the east, consisting of larch trees, pines, Siberian cedars, firs, and Pernambuco and Campeachy woods. These trunks appear to have been swept away by the great rivers of Asia and America. Some of them are brought from the Gulf of Mexico by the Bahama stream; while others are hurried forward by the current which, to the north of Siberia, constantly sets in from east to west. Some of these trees have been deprived of their bark by friction, but are in such a state of preservation as to form excellent building timber.1064 Parts of the branches and almost all the roots remain fixed to the pines which have been drifted into the North Sea, into latitudes too cold for the growth of such timber, but the trunks are usually barked.

In a similar way, the bays of Spitzbergen are filled with driftwood, which also collects along the eastern parts of the Siberian coast. This wood includes larch, pine, Siberian cedar, fir, and woods from Pernambuco and Campeachy. These logs seem to have been carried away by the major rivers of Asia and America. Some are transported from the Gulf of Mexico by the Bahama current, while others are pushed along by the current that flows from east to west north of Siberia. Some of these trees have lost their bark due to friction but are still well-preserved enough to be great building material.1064 Parts of the branches and almost all the roots remain attached to the pines that have drifted into the North Sea, in latitudes too cold for such timber to grow, but the trunks are usually stripped of bark.

The leaves and lighter parts of plants are seldom carried out to sea, in any part of the globe, except during tropical hurricanes among islands, and during the agitations of the atmosphere which sometimes accompany earthquakes and volcanic eruptions.

The leaves and lighter parts of plants are rarely taken out to sea anywhere in the world, except during tropical hurricanes near islands, and during the disturbances in the atmosphere that sometimes happen alongside earthquakes and volcanic eruptions.

Comparative number of living and fossilized species of plants.—It will appear from these observations that, although the remains of terrestrial vegetation, borne down by aqueous causes from the land, are chiefly deposited at the bottom of lakes or at the mouths of rivers, yet a considerable quantity is drifted about in all directions by currents, and may become imbedded in any marine formation, or may sink down, when water-logged, to the bottom of unfathomable abysses, and there accumulate without intermixture with other substances.

Comparative number of living and fossilized species of plants.—From these observations, it seems that while the remains of land plants, carried by water from the land, mostly settle at the bottoms of lakes or river mouths, a significant amount is moved around by currents and can become trapped in any marine formation. They might also sink, when saturated with water, to the depths of unfathomable abysses, where they can accumulate without mixing with other materials.

It may be asked whether we have any data for inferring that the remains of a considerable proportion of the existing species of plants will be permanently preserved, so as to be hereafter recognizable, supposing the strata now in progress to be at some future period upraised? To this inquiry it may be answered, that there are no reasons for expecting that more than a small number of the plants now flourishing in the globe will become fossilized; since the entire habitations of a great number of them are remote from lakes and seas, and even where they grow near to large bodies of water, the circumstances are quite accidental and partial which 746 favor the imbedding and conservation of vegetable remains. Suppose, for example, that the species of plants inhabiting the hydrographical basin of the Rhine, or that region, extending from the Alps to the sea, which is watered by the Rhine and its numerous tributaries, to be about 2500 in number, exclusive of the cryptogamic class. This estimate is by no means exaggerated; yet if a geologist could explore the deposits which have resulted from the sediment of the Rhine in the Lake of Constance, and off the coast of Holland, he could scarcely expect to obtain from the recent strata the leaves, wood, and seeds of fifty species in such a state of preservation as to enable a botanist to determine their specific characters with certainty.

It might be questioned whether we have any evidence to suggest that the remains of a significant number of today’s plant species will be permanently preserved and recognizable in the future, assuming the current layers of earth are eventually lifted. To answer this question, we can say that there’s little reason to expect that more than a small fraction of the plants currently thriving on Earth will become fossilized. Many of them live far from lakes and seas, and even the ones that grow near large bodies of water do so under accidental and limited conditions that allow for the embedding and preservation of plant remains. For instance, consider that the number of plant species in the Rhine watershed—extending from the Alps to the sea and fed by the Rhine and its many tributaries—could be around 2,500, not counting the cryptogams. This estimate is quite realistic, yet if a geologist were to examine the sediment left by the Rhine in Lake Constance or off the coast of Holland, they would likely find it nearly impossible to recover from the recent layers the leaves, wood, and seeds of fifty species well enough for a botanist to confidently identify their specific characteristics.

Those naturalists, therefore, who infer that the ancient flora of the globe was, at certain periods, less varied than now, merely because they have as yet discovered only a few hundred fossil species of a particular epoch, while they can enumerate more than one hundred thousand living ones, are reasoning on a false basis, and their standard of comparison is not the same in the two cases.

Those naturalists who conclude that the ancient plant life of the Earth was less diverse at certain times compared to now, just because they have only found a few hundred fossil species from a specific period, while they can count over one hundred thousand living species, are making an incorrect assumption, and their comparison is not valid in both instances.

Submarine forests on coast of Hants.—We have already seen that the submarine position of several forests, or the remains of trees standing in a vertical position on the British shores, has been due, in some instances, to the subsidence of land.1065 There are some cases which require a different explanation. My friend, Mr. Charles Harris, discovered, in 1831, evident traces of a fir-wood beneath the mean level of the sea, at Bournmouth, in Hampshire, the formation having been laid open during a low spring tide. It is composed of peat and wood, and is situated between the beach and a bar of sand about 200 yards off, and extends fifty yards along the shore. It also lies in the direct line of the Bournmouth Valley, from the termination of which it is separated by 200 yards of shingle and drift-sand. Down the valley flows a large brook, traversing near its mouth a considerable tract of rough, boggy, and heathy ground, which produces a few birch-trees, and a great abundance of the Myrica gale. Seventy-six rings of annual growth were counted in a transverse section of one of the buried fir-trees, which was fourteen inches in diameter. Besides the stumps and roots of fir, pieces of alder and birch are found in the peat; and it is a curious fact, that a part of many of the trees have been converted into iron pyrites. The peat rests on pebbly strata, precisely similar to the sand and pebbles occurring on the adjoining heaths.

Submarine forests on the coast of Hants.—We have already noted that the underwater location of several forests, or the remains of trees standing upright on British shores, is in some cases due to the sinking of land.1065 However, some instances require a different explanation. My friend, Mr. Charles Harris, discovered, in 1831, clear traces of a fir forest beneath the average sea level at Bournemouth, in Hampshire, which were revealed during a low spring tide. It consists of peat and wood, located between the beach and a sandbar about 200 yards offshore, extending fifty yards along the coast. It also lies directly in line with the Bournemouth Valley, from which it is separated by 200 yards of shingle and drift sand. A large brook flows down the valley, passing through a significant area of rough, boggy, and heath-like ground that produces a few birch trees and a large amount of Myrica gale. Seventy-six rings of annual growth were counted in a cross-section of one of the buried fir trees, which was fourteen inches in diameter. In addition to the stumps and roots of fir trees, pieces of alder and birch can be found in the peat; interestingly, part of many of the trees has turned into iron pyrites. The peat sits on pebbly layers, very similar to the sand and pebbles found on the nearby heaths.

As the sea is encroaching on this shore, we may suppose that at some former period the Bourne Valley extended farther, and that its extremity consisted, as at present, of boggy ground, partly clothed with fir-trees. The bog rested on that bed of pebbles which we now see below the peat; and the sea, in its progressive encroachments, eventually laid bare, at low water, the sandy foundations; upon which a stream of fresh water, rushing through the sand at the fall of the tides, carried out loose sand with it. The super-stratum of vegetable matter, being matted and 747 bound together by the roots of trees, remained; but being undermined, sank down below the level of the sea, and then the waves washed sand and shingle over it. In support of this hypothesis, it may be observed, that small streams of fresh water often pass under the sands of the sea-beach, so that they may be crossed dry-shod; and the water is seen, at the point where it issues, to carry out sand and even pebbles.

As the sea moves closer to this shore, we can assume that at some earlier time, the Bourne Valley extended further, and its edge was, like today, made up of marshy land, partially covered with fir trees. The swamp rested on the layer of pebbles we see beneath the peat now; and as the sea continued to encroach, it eventually exposed, at low tide, the sandy base beneath, where a stream of fresh water, flowing through the sand as the tide fell, carried away loose sand. The layer of plant matter, bound together by tree roots, stayed intact, but when it was undermined, it sank below sea level, allowing the waves to wash sand and gravel over it. To support this theory, it’s worth noting that small streams of fresh water often flow beneath the sands of the beach, allowing us to cross without getting wet; and when the water emerges, it carries sand and even pebbles with it.

Mineralization of plants—Although the botanist and chemist have as yet been unable to explain fully the manner in which wood becomes petrified, it is nevertheless ascertained that, under favorable circumstances, the lapidifying process is now continually going on. A piece of wood was lately procured by Mr. Stokes, from an ancient Roman aqueduct in Westphalia, in which some portions were converted into spindle-shaped bodies, consisting of carbonate of lime, while the rest of the wood remained in a comparatively unchanged state.1066 It appears that in some cases the most perishable, in others the most durable, portions of plants are preserved, variations which doubtless depend on the time when the mineral matter was supplied. If introduced immediately, on the first commencement of decomposition, then the most destructible parts are lapidified, while the more durable do not waste away till afterwards, when the supply has failed, and so never become petrified. The converse of these circumstances gives rise to exactly opposite results.

Mineralization of plants—Although scientists in botany and chemistry still haven't fully figured out how wood turns into stone, it's clear that, under the right conditions, the process of mineralization is constantly happening. Recently, Mr. Stokes acquired a piece of wood from an ancient Roman aqueduct in Westphalia, where some parts had turned into spindle-shaped forms made of calcium carbonate, while the rest of the wood remained relatively unchanged.1066 It seems that in some cases, the most fragile parts are preserved, while in others, the more durable sections are maintained. These differences likely depend on when the mineral matter was introduced. If it’s added right at the start of decomposition, the most easily breakable parts are mineralized, while the sturdier parts don't start to break down until later, when the mineral supply has run out and thus never become petrified. The opposite scenario leads to exactly the reverse results.

Professor Göppert, of Breslau, has instituted a series of curious experiments, in which he has succeeded in producing some very remarkable imitations of fossil petrifactions. He placed recent ferns between soft layers of clay, dried these in the shade, and then slowly and gradually heated them, till they were red-hot. The result was the production of so perfect a counterpart of fossil plants as might have deceived an experienced geologist. According to the different degrees of heat applied, the plants were obtained in a brown or perfectly carbonized condition; and sometimes, but more rarely, they were in a black shining state, adhering closely to the layer of clay. If the red heat was sustained until all the organic matter was burnt up, only an impression of the plant remained.

Professor Göppert from Breslau has conducted a series of intriguing experiments in which he has successfully created some remarkable replicas of fossil petrifications. He placed recent ferns between soft layers of clay, dried them in the shade, and then slowly and gradually heated them until they were red-hot. The outcome was a perfect imitation of fossil plants that could have fooled an experienced geologist. Depending on the different levels of heat applied, the plants ended up in a brown or completely carbonized state; and sometimes, though less often, they appeared in a shiny black state, closely adhering to the layer of clay. If the red heat was maintained until all the organic material was burned away, only an impression of the plant was left.

The same chemist steeped plants in a moderately strong solution of sulphate of iron, and left them immersed in it for several days, until they were thoroughly soaked in the liquid. They were then dried, and kept heated until they would no longer shrink in volume, and until every trace of organic matter had disappeared. On cooling them he found that the oxide formed by this process had taken the form of the plants. A variety of other experiments were made by steeping animal and vegetable substances in siliceous, calcareous, and metallic solutions, and all tended to prove that the mineralization of organic bodies can be carried much farther in a short time than had been previously supposed.1067

The same chemist soaked plants in a moderately strong solution of iron sulfate and left them immersed for several days until they were completely saturated. They were then dried and heated until they wouldn’t shrink anymore and until all organic matter had vanished. When cooled, he found that the oxide created by this process had taken on the shape of the plants. He conducted a variety of other experiments by soaking animal and plant materials in silica, calcium, and metallic solutions, which all indicated that the mineralization of organic materials can go much further in a short time than was previously thought.1067

Imbedding of the Remains of Insects.

I have observed the elytra and other parts of beetles in a band of fissile clay, separating two beds of recent shell-marl, in the Loch of Kinnordy in Forfarshire. Amongst these, Mr. Curtis recognized Elator lineatus and Atopa cervina, species still living in Scotland. These, as well as other remains which accompanied them, appear to belong to terrestrial, not aquatic species, and must have been carried down in muddy water during an inundation. In the lacustrine peat of the same locality, the elytra of beetles are not uncommon; but in the deposits of drained lakes generally, and in the silt of our estuaries, the relics of this class of the animal kingdom are rare. In the blue clay of very modern origin of Lewes levels, Dr. Mantell has found the Indusia, or cases of the larvæ of Phryganea, in abundance, with minute shells belonging to the genera Planorbis, Limnea, &c., adhering to them.1068

I have seen the hard wings and other parts of beetles in a layer of soft clay, separating two beds of recent shell-marl, in the Loch of Kinnordy in Forfarshire. Among these, Mr. Curtis identified Elator lineatus and Atopa cervina, species that are still found in Scotland. These, along with other remains found with them, seem to belong to terrestrial, not aquatic species, and must have been washed down in muddy water during a flood. In the lake peat of the same area, the hard wings of beetles are fairly common; but in the deposits of drained lakes in general, and in the silt of our estuaries, remains of this group of animals are rare. In the blue clay of very recent origin in Lewes levels, Dr. Mantell has discovered the cases of the larvae of Phryganea in large numbers, along with tiny shells from the genera Planorbis, Limnea, etc., attached to them.1068

When speaking of the migrations of insects, I pointed out that an immense number are floated into lakes and seas by rivers, or blown by winds far from the land; but they are so buoyant that we can only suppose them, under very peculiar circumstances, to sink to the bottom before they are either devoured by insectivorous animals or decomposed.

When talking about insect migrations, I mentioned that a huge number are carried into lakes and seas by rivers, or blown far from land by the wind; however, they are so buoyant that we can only assume they sink to the bottom under very specific conditions before being eaten by insect-eating animals or breaking down.

Remains of Reptiles.

As the bodies of several crocodiles were found in the mud brought down to the sea by the river inundation which attended an earthquake in Java, in the year 1699, we may imagine that extraordinary floods of mud may stifle many individuals of the shoals of alligators and other reptiles which frequent lakes and the deltas of rivers in tropical climates. Thousands of frogs were found leaping about among the wreck, carried into the sea by the inundations in Morayshire, in 1829;1069 and it is evident that whenever a sea-cliff is undermined, or land is swept by other violent causes into the sea, land reptiles may be carried in.

As the bodies of several crocodiles were discovered in the mud brought to the sea by the river floods caused by an earthquake in Java in 1699, we can imagine that extreme mud floods could suffocate many alligators and other reptiles that live in lakes and river deltas in tropical regions. Thousands of frogs were seen hopping around among the debris, carried into the sea by the floods in Morayshire in 1829;1069 and it’s clear that whenever a sea cliff is eroded, or land is washed away by other violent forces into the sea, terrestrial reptiles can be swept in.

Remains of Birds.

We might have anticipated that the imbedding of the remains of birds in new strata would be of very rare occurrence; for their powers of flight insure them against perishing, by numerous casualties to which quadrupeds are exposed during floods; and if they chance to be drowned, or to die when swimming on the water, it will scarcely ever happen that they will be submerged so as to become preserved in sedimentary deposits. In consequence of the hollow tubular structure of their bones and the quantity of their feathers, they are extremely light in proportion to their volume; so that when first killed they do not sink to the bottom like 749 quadrupeds, but float on the surface until the carcass either rots away or is devoured by predaceous animals. To these causes we may ascribe the absence of any vestige of the bones of birds in the recent marl formations of Scotland; although these lakes, until the moment when they were artificially drained, were frequented by a great abundance of waterfowl.

We might have expected that the embedding of bird remains in new layers would happen very rarely because their ability to fly protects them from many dangers that quadrupeds face during floods. If they do happen to drown or die while swimming, it’s unlikely they will be buried deep enough to be preserved in sediment. Because their bones are hollow and lightweight, they don't sink like quadrupeds do; instead, they float on the surface until their bodies either decay or are eaten by predators. This explains why there are no traces of bird bones in the recent marl formations of Scotland, even though these lakes were often visited by many waterfowl before they were drained.

Imbedding of Terrestrial Quadrupeds.

River inundations recur in most climates at very irregular intervals, and expend their fury on those rich alluvial plains where herds of herbivorous quadrupeds congregate together. These animals are often surprised; and, being unable to stem the current, are hurried along until they are drowned, when they sink at first immediately to the bottom. Here their bodies are drifted along, together with sediment, into lakes or seas, and may then be covered by a mass of mud, sand, and pebbles, thrown down upon them. If there be no sediment superimposed, the gases generated by putrefaction usually cause the bodies to rise again to the surface about the ninth, or at latest the fourteenth day. The pressure of a thin covering of mud would not be sufficient to retain them at the bottom; for we see the putrid carcasses of dogs and cats, even in rivers, floating with considerable weights attached to them, and in sea-water they would be still more buoyant.

River floods happen in most climates at very irregular intervals and unleash their fury on the rich alluvial plains where herds of grazing animals gather. These animals are often caught off guard, and since they can't swim against the strong current, they are swept away until they're drowned, sinking straight to the bottom at first. Their bodies then float along with sediment into lakes or seas, where they may be covered by layers of mud, sand, and pebbles that pile on top. If no sediment settles on them, the gases produced by decay usually cause the bodies to rise back up to the surface around the ninth day, or at the latest the fourteenth day. A thin layer of mud on top isn't enough to keep them at the bottom; we see rotten bodies of dogs and cats floating down rivers even with heavy weights tied to them, and in seawater, they'd be even more buoyant.

Where the body is so buried in drift sand, or mud accumulated upon it, as never to rise again, the skeleton may be preserved entire; but if it comes again to the surface while in the process of putrefaction, the bones commonly fall piecemeal from the floating carcass, and may in that case be scattered at random over the bottom of the lake, estuary, or sea; so that a jaw may afterwards be found in one place, a rib in another, a humerus in a third—all included, perhaps, in a matrix of fine materials, where there may be evidence of slight transporting power in the current, or even of none, but simply of some chemical precipitate.

Where a body is buried in drift sand or mud so deeply that it never rises again, the skeleton may remain intact; however, if it surfaces during decomposition, the bones often break off from the floating remains and can be scattered randomly across the lake, estuary, or sea floor. This means a jaw might be found in one spot, a rib in another, a humerus in yet another—each possibly encased in fine sediments, showing signs of weak current transport, or perhaps just a chemical deposit with no current involved at all.

A large number of the bodies of drowned animals, if they float into the sea or a lake, especially in hot climates, are instantly devoured by sharks, alligators, and other carnivorous beasts, which may have power to digest even the bones; but during extraordinary floods, when the greatest number of land animals are destroyed, the waters are commonly so turbid, especially at the bottom of the channel, that even aquatic species are compelled to escape into some retreat where there is clearer water, lest they should be stifled. For this reason, as well as the rapidity of sedimentary deposition at such seasons, the probability of carcasses becoming permanently imbedded is considerable.

A lot of drowned animals that float into the sea or a lake, especially in hot climates, are quickly eaten by sharks, alligators, and other carnivorous creatures that can even digest the bones. However, during extreme floods, when the most land animals are lost, the waters tend to be really murky, especially at the bottom of the channel. Because of this, even aquatic species have to move to spots with clearer water to avoid suffocating. Due to this and the fast sediment buildup during these times, there’s a good chance that carcasses will end up permanently buried.

Flood in the Solway Firth, 1794.—One of the most memorable floods of modern date, in our island, is that which visited part of the southern borders of Scotland, on the 24th of January, 1794, and which spread particular devastation over the country adjoining the Solway Firth.

Flood in the Solway Firth, 1794.—One of the most significant floods in recent history in our country occurred on January 24, 1794, impacting parts of the southern borders of Scotland and causing widespread destruction in the areas around the Solway Firth.

750 We learn from the account of Captain Napier, that the heavy rains had swollen every stream which entered the Firth of Solway; so that the inundation not only carried away a great number of cattle and sheep, but many of the herdsmen and shepherds, washing down their bodies into the estuary. After the storm, when the flood subsided, an extraordinary spectacle was seen on a large sand-bank called "the beds of Esk," where there is a meeting of the tidal waters, and where heavy bodies are usually left stranded after great floods. On this single bank were found collected together the bodies of 9 black cattle, 3 horses, 1840 sheep, 45 dogs, 180 hares, besides a great number of smaller animals, and, mingled with the rest, the corpses of two men and one woman.1070

750 We hear from Captain Napier's account that the heavy rains had caused every stream flowing into the Firth of Solway to overflow. As a result, the flood not only swept away a large number of cattle and sheep but also many herdsmen and shepherds, carrying their bodies into the estuary. After the storm, when the floodwaters receded, an extraordinary sight was observed on a large sandbank known as "the beds of Esk," where the tidal waters converge and heavy objects are usually left stranded after major floods. On this single bank, the bodies of 9 black cattle, 3 horses, 1840 sheep, 45 dogs, 180 hares, in addition to a large number of smaller animals, were found together, alongside the remains of two men and one woman.1070

Floods in Scotland, 1829.—In those more recent floods in Scotland, in August, 1829, whereby a fertile district on the east coast became a scene of dreadful desolation, a vast number of animals and plants were washed from the land, and found scattered about after the storm, around the mouths of the principal rivers. An eye-witness thus describes the scene which presented itself at the mouth of the Spey, in Morayshire:—"For several miles along the beach crowds were employed in endeavoring to save the wood and other wreck with which the heavy-rolling tide was loaded; whilst the margin of the sea was strewed with the carcasses of domestic animals, and with millions of dead hares and rabbits."1071

Floods in Scotland, 1829.—In the more recent floods in Scotland, in August 1829, a fertile area on the east coast turned into a scene of terrible devastation. A huge number of animals and plants were swept from the land and found scattered after the storm, particularly around the mouths of the main rivers. An eyewitness described the scene at the mouth of the Spey in Morayshire: “For several miles along the beach, crowds were trying to save the wood and other debris that the heavy tide had brought in; meanwhile, the shoreline was covered with the bodies of farm animals, along with millions of dead hares and rabbits.”1071

Savannahs of South America.—We are informed by Humboldt, that during the periodical swellings of the large rivers in South America great numbers of quadrupeds are annually drowned. Of the wild horses, for example, which graze in immense troops in the savannahs, thousands are said to perish when the river Apure, a tributary of the Orinoco, is swollen, before they have time to reach the rising ground of the Llanos. The mares, during the season of high water, may be seen, followed by their colts, swimming about and feeding on the grass, of which the top alone waves above the waters. In this state they are pursued by crocodiles; and their thighs frequently bear the prints of the teeth of these carnivorous reptiles. "Such is the pliability," observes the celebrated traveller, "of the organization of the animals which man has subjected to his sway, that horses, cows, and other species of European origin, lead, for a time, an amphibious life, surrounded by crocodiles, water-serpents, and manatees. When the rivers return again into their beds, they roam in the savannah, which is then spread over with a fine odoriferous grass, and enjoy, as in their native climate, the renewed vegetation of spring."1072

Savannahs of South America.—Humboldt informs us that during the seasonal flooding of the large rivers in South America, many animals drown each year. For instance, thousands of wild horses that graze in vast herds in the savannahs are said to perish when the Apure River, a tributary of the Orinoco, floods, before they can reach the higher ground of the Llanos. During high water season, mares can be seen swimming with their colts, foraging for grass, with only the tops visible above the water. In this situation, they are chased by crocodiles, and their thighs often show the bite marks of these carnivorous reptiles. "Such is the adaptability," notes the famous traveler, "of the animals that man has tamed, that horses, cows, and other species from Europe live, for a time, a semi-aquatic life, surrounded by crocodiles, water snakes, and manatees. When the rivers recede, they roam the savannah, which is then covered with fragrant grass, and enjoy the rejuvenated vegetation of spring, just like in their original habitat." 1072

Floods of the Parana.—The great number of animals which are drowned in seasons of drought in the tributaries of the Plata, was before mentioned. Sir W. Parish states, that the Parana, flowing from the mountains of Brazil to the estuary of the Plata, is liable to great floods, 751 and during one of these, in the year 1812, vast quantities of cattle were carried away, "and when the waters began to subside, and the islands which they had covered became again visible, the whole atmosphere for a time was poisoned by the effluvia from the innumerable carcasses of skunks, capybaras, tigers, and other wild beasts which had been drowned."1073

Floods of the Parana.—The large number of animals that drown during droughts in the tributaries of the Plata was mentioned earlier. Sir W. Parish notes that the Parana, which flows from the mountains of Brazil to the estuary of the Plata, is prone to severe flooding, 751 and during one of these floods in 1812, a vast number of cattle were swept away. "When the waters began to recede, and the islands they had submerged became visible again, the entire atmosphere was temporarily contaminated by the stench from the countless carcasses of skunks, capybaras, tigers, and other wild animals that had drowned."1073

Floods of the Ganges.—We find it continually stated, by those who describe the Ganges and Burrampooter, that these rivers carry before them, during the flood season, not only floats of reeds and timber, but dead bodies of men, deer, and oxen.1074

Floods of the Ganges.—It’s often mentioned by those who write about the Ganges and Burrampooter rivers that during the flood season, these rivers carry not just debris like reeds and timber, but also the bodies of people, deer, and cattle.1074

In Java, 1699.—I have already referred to the effects of a flood which attended an earthquake in Java in 1699, when the turbid waters of the Batavian river destroyed all the fish except the carp; and when drowned buffaloes, tigers, rhinoceroses, deer, apes, and other wild beasts, were brought down to the sea-coast by the current, with several crocodiles which had been stifled in the mud. (See above, p. 503.)

In Java, 1699.—I've already mentioned the impact of a flood that followed an earthquake in Java in 1699, when the muddy waters of the Batavian river wiped out all the fish except for the carp; and when drowned buffaloes, tigers, rhinoceroses, deer, monkeys, and other wild animals were carried down to the coast by the current, along with several crocodiles that had drowned in the mud. (See above, p. 503.)

On the western side of the same island, in the territory of Galongoon, in the Regencies, a more recent volcanic eruption (that of 1822, before described) (see above, p. 431) was attended by a flood, during which the river Tandoi bore down hundreds of carcasses of rhinoceroses and buffaloes, and swept away more than one hundred men and women from a multitude assembled on its banks to celebrate a festival. Whether the bodies reached the sea, or were deposited, with drift matter, in some large intervening alluvial plains, we are not informed.1075

On the western side of the same island, in the Galongoon area, a recent volcanic eruption (the one from 1822, described earlier) (see above, p. 431) was accompanied by a flood, during which the Tandoi River carried hundreds of dead rhinoceroses and buffaloes and swept away more than one hundred men and women from a crowd gathered on its banks to celebrate a festival. We don't know if the bodies made it to the sea or were deposited, along with debris, in some large floodplains in between.1075

Sumatra.—"On the coast of Orissa," says Heynes, "I have seen tigers and whole herds of black cattle carried along by what are called freshes, and trees of immense size."1076

Sumatra.—"On the coast of Orissa," says Heynes, "I have seen tigers and entire herds of black cattle swept away by what we call floods, along with enormous trees." 1076

In Virginia, 1771.—I might enumerate a great number of local deluges that have swept through the fertile lands bordering on large rivers, especially in tropical countries, but I should surpass the limits assigned to this work. I may observe, however, that the destruction of the islands, in rivers, is often attended with great loss of lives. Thus when the principal river in Virginia rose, in 1771, to the height of twenty-five feet above its ordinary level, it swept entirely away Elk Island, on which were seven hundred head of quadrupeds,—horses, oxen, sheep, and hogs,—and nearly one hundred houses.1077

In Virginia, 1771.—I could list numerous local floods that have devastated the fertile lands along large rivers, particularly in tropical regions, but that would go beyond the scope of this work. However, I should point out that the destruction of islands in rivers often results in significant loss of life. For example, when the main river in Virginia rose to twenty-five feet above its normal level in 1771, it completely wiped out Elk Island, which had seven hundred animals—horses, cattle, sheep, and pigs—and nearly one hundred houses.1077

The reader will gather, from what was before said respecting the deposition of sediment by aqueous causes, that the greater number of the remains of quadrupeds drifted away by rivers must be intercepted by lakes before they reach the sea, or buried in freshwater formations near the mouths of rivers. If they are carried still farther, the probabilities are increased of their rising to the surface in a state of putrefaction, and, in that case, of being there devoured by aquatic beasts of prey, or of 752 subsiding into some spots whither no sediment is conveyed, and, consequently, where every vestige of them will, in the course of time, disappear.

The reader will understand from what was mentioned earlier about sediment being deposited by water that most of the remains of land animals carried away by rivers must be stopped by lakes before they reach the ocean, or buried in freshwater deposits near the river mouths. If they travel even further, it's more likely that they will rise to the surface in a decayed state, and in that case, they could be eaten by predatory animals, or 752 sink into areas where no sediment is delivered, and as a result, where all traces of them will eventually disappear.

Skeletons of animals in recent shell-marl, Scotland.—In some instances, the skeletons of quadrupeds are met with abundantly in recent shell-marls in Scotland, where we cannot suppose them to have been imbedded by the action of rivers or floods. They all belong to species which now inhabit, or are known to have been indigenous in Scotland. The remains of several hundred skeletons have been procured within the last century from five or six small lakes in Forfarshire, where shell-marl has been worked. Those of the stag (Cervus Elaphas) are most numerous; and if the others be arranged in the order of their relative abundance, they will nearly follow thus—the ox, the boar, the horse, the sheep, the dog, the hare, the fox, the wolf, and the cat. The beaver seems extremely rare; but it has been found in the shell-marl of Loch Marlie, in Perthshire, and in the parish of Edrom, in Berwickshire.

Skeletons of animals in recent shell-marl, Scotland.—In some cases, the skeletons of four-legged animals are found in large numbers in recent shell-marls in Scotland, where we can't assume they were deposited by rivers or floods. All these species either currently live in Scotland or are known to have been native there. Over the past century, several hundred skeletons have been collected from five or six small lakes in Forfarshire, where shell-marl has been extracted. The remains of the stag (Cervus Elaphas) are the most common; and if we list the others in order of their relative abundance, it would approximately be—the ox, the boar, the horse, the sheep, the dog, the hare, the fox, the wolf, and the cat. The beaver appears to be quite rare; however, it has been found in the shell-marl of Loch Marlie in Perthshire, and in the parish of Edrom in Berwickshire.

In the greater part of these lake-deposits there are no signs of floods; and the expanse of water was originally so confined, that the smallest of the above-mentioned quadrupeds could have crossed, by swimming from one shore to the other. Deer, and such species as take readily to the water, may often have been mired in trying to land, where the bottom was soft and quaggy, and in their efforts to escape may have plunged deeper into the marly bottom. Some individuals, I suspect, of different species, have fallen in when crossing the frozen surface in winter; for nothing can be more treacherous than the ice when covered with snow, in consequence of the springs, which are numerous, and which, retaining always an equal temperature, cause the ice, in certain spots, to be extremely thin, while in every other part of the lake it is strong enough to bear the heaviest weights.

In most of these lake deposits, there are no signs of flooding; the area of water was originally so small that the smallest of the mentioned land animals could have swum from one shore to the other. Deer and other animals that are good in water might have often gotten stuck trying to reach the shore where the ground was soft and boggy, and in their attempts to get free, they may have sunk deeper into the muddy bottom. I suspect that some individuals from different species have fallen in when crossing the frozen surface in winter; nothing is more deceptive than snow-covered ice because of the numerous springs that maintain a constant temperature, causing the ice in certain areas to be really thin, while in other parts of the lake, it's strong enough to support heavy weights.

Mammiferous remains in marine strata.—As the bones of mammalia are often so abundantly preserved in peat, and such lakes as have just been described, the encroachments of a sea upon a coast may sometimes throw down the imbedded skeletons, so that they may be carried away by tides and currents, and entombed in submarine formations. Some of the smaller quadrupeds, also, which burrow in the ground, as well as reptiles and every species of plant, are liable to be cast down into the waves by this cause, which must not be overlooked, although probably of comparatively small importance amongst the numerous agents whereby terrestrial organic remains are included in submarine strata.

Mammal remains in marine layers.—Because the bones of mammals are often well-preserved in peat and in the lakes that have just been described, when the sea encroaches on a coast, it can sometimes expose buried skeletons, which may then be swept away by tides and currents and buried in underwater formations. Some of the smaller land mammals that dig in the ground, as well as reptiles and every type of plant, can also be washed into the waves for this reason, which shouldn't be overlooked, even though it is likely of relatively minor importance compared to the many factors that contribute to the inclusion of land organic remains in underwater layers.

During the great earthquake of Conception in 1835, some cattle, which were standing on the steep sides of the island of Quiriquina, were rolled by the shock into the sea, while on a low island at the head of the Bay of Conception seventy animals were washed off by a great wave and drowned.1078

During the massive earthquake in Conception in 1835, some cattle that were standing on the steep slopes of Quiriquina Island were knocked into the sea by the shock, while on a low island at the top of the Bay of Conception, seventy animals were swept away by a huge wave and drowned.1078


CHAPTER XLVIII.

IMBEDDING OF THE REMAINS OF MAN AND HIS WORKS IN SUBAQUEOUS STRATA.

Drifting of human bodies to the sea by river inundations—Destruction of bridges and houses—Loss of lives by shipwreck—How human corpses may be preserved in recent deposits—Number of wrecked vessels—Fossil skeletons of men—Fossil canoes, ships, and works of art—Chemical changes which metallic articles have undergone after long submergence—Imbedding of cities and forests in subaqueous strata by subsidence—Earthquake of Cutch in 1819—Buried Temples of Cashmere—Berkeley's arguments for the recent date of the creation of man—Concluding remarks.

Drifting of human bodies to the sea due to river floods—Destruction of bridges and houses—Loss of lives from shipwrecks—How human remains can be preserved in recent deposits—Number of wrecked vessels—Fossil skeletons of humans—Fossil canoes, ships, and works of art—Chemical changes that metallic items have gone through after being submerged for a long time—Cities and forests embedded in underwater layers due to sinking—Earthquake in Cutch in 1819—Buried temples of Cashmere—Berkeley's arguments for a recent creation date of humanity—Concluding remarks.

I shall now proceed to inquire in what manner the mortal remains of man and the works of his hands may be permanently preserved in subaqueous strata. Of the many hundred million human beings which perish in the course of every century on the land, every vestige is usually destroyed in the course of a few thousand years; but of the smaller number that perish in the waters, a certain proportion must be entombed under circumstances that may enable parts of them to endure throughout entire geological epochs.

I will now look into how human remains and their creations can be permanently preserved in underwater layers. Of the many hundreds of millions of people who die on land every century, all traces are usually lost within a few thousand years; however, of the smaller number who die in water, some are buried in conditions that might allow parts of them to last through entire geological eras.

The bodies of men, together with those of the inferior animals, are occasionally washed down during river inundations into seas and lakes. (See pp. 726-728.) Belzoni witnessed a flood on the Nile in September, 1818, where, although the river rose only three feet and a half above its ordinary level, several villages, with some hundreds of men, women, and children, were swept away.1079 It was before mentioned that a rise of six feet of water in the Ganges, in 1763, was attended with a much greater loss of lives. (See above, p. 278.)

The bodies of men, along with those of lesser animals, are sometimes swept down during river floods into oceans and lakes. (See pp. 726-728.) Belzoni observed a flood on the Nile in September 1818, where, despite the river rising only three and a half feet above its normal level, several villages, along with hundreds of men, women, and children, were carried away.1079 It was previously mentioned that a six-foot rise in the Ganges in 1763 caused an even greater loss of life. (See above, p. 278.)

In the year 1771, when the inundations in the north of England appear to have equalled the floods of Morayshire in 1829, a great number of houses and their inhabitants were swept away by the rivers Tyne, Can, Wear, Tees, and Greta; and no less than twenty-one bridges were destroyed in the courses of these rivers. At the village of Bywell the flood tore the dead bodies and coffins out of the churchyard, and bore them away, together with many of the living inhabitants. During the same tempest an immense number of cattle, horses, and sheep, were also transported to the sea, while the whole coast was covered with the wreck of ships. Four centuries before (in 1338), the same district had been visited by a similar continuance of heavy rains, followed by disastrous floods, and it is not improbable that these catastrophes may recur periodically, though at uncertain intervals. As the population increases, and 754 buildings and bridges are multiplied, we must expect the loss of lives and property to augment.1080

In 1771, when the floods in northern England seemed to match those in Morayshire in 1829, many houses and their residents were swept away by the Tyne, Can, Wear, Tees, and Greta rivers. In total, twenty-one bridges were destroyed along these rivers. At the village of Bywell, the flood uprooted the dead bodies and coffins from the churchyard, carrying them off along with many living residents. During the same storm, countless cattle, horses, and sheep were also swept out to sea, while the entire coast was littered with shipwrecks. Four centuries earlier (in 1338), that same area faced a similar prolonged period of heavy rainfall, leading to disastrous floods, and it’s likely that such disasters could happen again periodically, though at unpredictable intervals. As the population grows and more buildings and bridges are built, we should expect an increase in loss of life and property. 754 1080

Fossilization of human bodies in the bed of the sea.—If to the hundreds of human bodies committed to the deep in the way of ordinary burial we add those of individuals lost by shipwrecks, we shall find that in the course of a single year, a great number of human remains are consigned to the subaqueous regions. I shall hereafter advert to a calculation by which it appears that more than five hundred British vessels alone, averaging each a burthen of about 120 tons, are wrecked, and sink to the bottom, annually. Of these the crews for the most part escape, although it sometimes happens that all perish. In one great naval action several thousand individuals sometimes share a watery grave.

Fossilization of human bodies in the bed of the sea.—When we consider the hundreds of human bodies buried at sea through regular burial methods and add those from shipwrecks, we realize that a significant number of human remains end up in underwater locations each year. I will later refer to a calculation showing that more than five hundred British vessels, each with an average weight of about 120 tons, are wrecked and sink to the ocean floor, annually. Most crew members usually survive, although sometimes everyone on board does not make it. In a major naval battle, it's common for several thousand individuals to share a watery grave.

Many of these corpses are instantly devoured by predaceous fish, sometimes before they reach the bottom; still more frequently when they rise again to the surface, and float in a state of putrefaction. Many decompose on the floor of the ocean, where no sediment is thrown down upon them; but if they fall upon a reef where corals and shells are becoming agglutinated into a solid rock, or subside where the delta of a river is advancing, they may be preserved for an incalculable series of ages.

Many of these bodies are quickly eaten by carnivorous fish, sometimes even before they hit the bottom; more often, they're consumed when they come back up to the surface and float in a state of decay. Many decompose on the ocean floor, where no sediment covers them; however, if they land on a reef where corals and shells are hardening into solid rock, or settle where a river delta is forming, they can be preserved for countless ages.

Often at the distance of a few hundred feet from a coral reef, where wrecks are not unfrequent, there are no soundings at the depth of many hundred fathoms. Canoes, merchant vessels, and ships of war, may have sunk and have been enveloped, in such situations, in calcareous sand and breccia, detached by the breakers from the summit of a submarine mountain. Should a volcanic eruption happen to cover such remains with ashes and sand, and a current of lava be afterwards poured over them, the ships and human skeletons might remain uninjured beneath the superincumbent mass, like the houses and works of art in the subterranean cities of Campania. Already many human remains may have been thus preserved beneath formations more than a thousand feet in thickness; for, in some volcanic archipelagoes, a period of thirty or forty centuries might well be supposed sufficient for such an accumulation. It was stated, that at the distance of about forty miles from the base of the delta of the Ganges there is an elliptical space about fifteen miles in diameter, where soundings of from 100 to 300 fathoms sometimes fail to reach the bottom. (See above, p. 279.) As during the flood season the quantity of mud and sand poured by the great rivers into the Bay of Bengal is so great that the sea only recovers its transparency at the distance of sixty miles from the coast, this depression must be gradually shoaling, especially as during the monsoons, the sea loaded with mud and sand, is beaten back in that direction towards the delta. Now, if a ship or human body sink to the bottom in such a spot, it is by no means improbable that it may become buried under a depth of a thousand feet of sediment in the same number of years.

Often just a few hundred feet from a coral reef, where wrecks are fairly common, there are no soundings at depths of many hundred fathoms. Canoes, merchant ships, and naval vessels may have sunk and become buried in this situation under calcareous sand and breccia, washed away by the waves from the top of a submerged mountain. If a volcanic eruption were to cover such remains with ash and sand, and a flow of lava were then poured over them, the ships and human skeletons might stay intact beneath the heavy mass, much like the houses and artworks in the buried cities of Campania. Many human remains may have been preserved beneath formations over a thousand feet thick; in some volcanic island chains, a period of thirty or forty centuries could easily create such an accumulation. It has been reported that about forty miles from the base of the Ganges delta, there is an elliptical area about fifteen miles wide where soundings of 100 to 300 fathoms sometimes do not reach the bottom. (See above, p. 279.) During the flood season, the amount of mud and sand carried by the major rivers into the Bay of Bengal is so vast that the sea only regains its clarity about sixty miles from the shore. This depression must be gradually filling in, especially since during the monsoon season, mud and sand-laden waters are pushed back toward the delta. So, if a ship or human body were to sink in such a location, it’s quite likely it could be buried under a thousand feet of sediment within the same number of years.

755 Even on that part of the floor of the ocean to which no accession of drift matter is carried (a part which probably constitutes, at any given period, by far the larger proportion of the whole submarine area), there are circumstances accompanying a wreck which favor the conservation of skeletons. For when the vessel fills suddenly with water, especially in the night, many persons are drowned between decks and in their cabins, so that their bodies are prevented from rising again to the surface. The vessel often strikes upon an uneven bottom, and is overturned; in which case the ballast, consisting of sand, shingle, and rock, or the cargo, frequently composed of heavy and durable materials, may be thrown down upon the carcasses. In the case of ships of war, cannon, shot, and other warlike stores, may press down with their weight the timbers of the vessel as they decay, and beneath these and the metallic substances the bones of man may be preserved.

755 Even in the parts of the ocean floor where no debris washes up (which likely makes up the majority of the underwater area at any time), there are factors related to a shipwreck that help preserve skeletons. When a ship suddenly fills with water, especially at night, many people drown below deck and in their cabins, preventing their bodies from floating back to the surface. The ship often hits an uneven seabed and capsizes; in this situation, the ballast made of sand, gravel, and rocks, or the cargo, often made of heavy and durable materials, can fall onto the bodies. For warships, cannons, ammunition, and other military supplies can crush the ship's timbers as they decay, and beneath these and the metal objects, human bones can be preserved.

Number of wrecked vessels.—When we reflect on the number of curious monuments consigned to the bed of the ocean in the course of every naval war from the earliest times, our conceptions are greatly raised respecting the multiplicity of lasting memorials which man is leaving of his labors. During our last great struggle with France, thirty-two of our ships of the line went to the bottom in the space of twenty-two years, besides seven 50-gun ships, eighty-six frigates, and a multitude of smaller vessels. The navies of the other European powers, France, Holland, Spain, and Denmark, were almost annihilated during the same period, so that the aggregate of their losses must have many times exceeded that of Great Britain. In every one of these ships were batteries of cannon constructed of iron or brass, whereof a great number had the dates and places of their manufacture inscribed upon them in letters cast in metal. In each there were coins of copper, silver, and often many of gold, capable of serving as valuable historical monuments; in each were an infinite variety of instruments of the arts of war and peace; many formed of materials, such as glass and earthenware, capable of lasting for indefinite ages when once removed from the mechanical action of the waves, and buried under a mass of matter which may exclude the corroding action of sea-water. The quantity, moreover, of timber which is conveyed from the land to the bed of the sea by the sinking of ships of a large size is enormous, for it is computed that 2000 tons of wood are required for the building of one 74-gun ship; and reckoning fifty oaks of 100 years growth to the acre, it would require forty acres of oak forest to build one of these vessels.1081

Number of wrecked vessels.—When we think about the number of fascinating monuments that have been sent to the ocean floor during every naval war throughout history, we realize just how many lasting reminders of human effort have been left behind. During our last major conflict with France, thirty-two of our battleships sank over twenty-two years, along with seven 50-gun ships, eighty-six frigates, and a host of smaller vessels. The navies of other European powers, including France, Holland, Spain, and Denmark, were nearly wiped out during that same time, meaning their total losses must have far surpassed those of Great Britain. Each of these ships carried cannons made of iron or brass, many of which were engraved with the dates and locations of their manufacture. Each ship also contained coins made of copper, silver, and often gold, which could serve as valuable historical artifacts; there were countless various tools for both war and peace; many made from materials like glass and pottery that could last for ages if kept away from the turbulent action of the waves, buried under a layer of debris that could protect them from the corrosive power of seawater. The amount of timber that moves from land to the sea due to the sinking of large ships is staggering, as it is estimated that 2,000 tons of wood are needed to build a single 74-gun ship; considering that fifty oaks of 100 years old are needed per acre, it would take forty acres of oak forest to construct one of these vessels.1081

It would be an error to imagine that the fury of war is more conducive than the peaceful spirit of commercial enterprise to the accumulation of wrecked vessels in the bed of the sea. From an examination of Lloyd's lists, from the year 1793 to the commencement of 1829, Captain W. H. Smyth ascertained that the number of British vessels alone lost during that period amounted on an average to no less than one and a half daily; 756 an extent of loss which would hardly have been anticipated, although we learn from Moreau's tables that the number of merchant vessels employed at one time, in the navigation of England and Scotland, amounts to about twenty thousand, having one with another a mean burthen of 120 tons.1082 My friend, Mr. J. L. Prevost, also informs me that on inspecting Lloyd's list for the years 1829, 1830, and 1831, he finds that no less than 1953 vessels were lost in those three years, their average tonnage being about 150 tons, or in all nearly 300,000 tons, being at the enormous rate of 100,000 tons annually of the merchant vessels of one nation only. This increased loss arises, I presume, from increasing activity in commerce.

It would be a mistake to think that the chaos of war leads to more shipwrecks than the calm environment of trade. From looking at Lloyd's lists from 1793 to the start of 1829, Captain W. H. Smyth found that an average of at least one and a half British vessels were lost each day during that time; 756 this level of loss was unexpected, even though Moreau's tables show that around twenty thousand merchant vessels were active in the navigation of England and Scotland at one time, each averaging about 120 tons.1082 My friend, Mr. J. L. Prevost, also tells me that after checking Lloyd's list for the years 1829, 1830, and 1831, he discovered that 1,953 vessels were lost in those three years, with an average tonnage of around 150 tons. In total, that’s nearly 300,000 tons, which translates to a staggering 100,000 tons per year for the merchant vessels of just one nation. This increase in losses, I suspect, comes from the growing activity in trade.

Out of 551 ships of the royal navy lost to the country during the period above mentioned, only 160 were taken or destroyed by the enemy, the rest having either stranded or foundered, or having been burnt by accident; a striking proof that the dangers of our naval warfare, however great, may be far exceeded by the storm, the shoal, the lee-shore, and all the other perils of the deep.1083

Out of 551 ships from the royal navy lost by the country during the mentioned period, only 160 were captured or destroyed by the enemy. The rest either ran aground, sank, or were accidentally burned. This clearly shows that the risks of our naval warfare, no matter how significant, can be overshadowed by storms, shallow waters, shorelines, and all the other dangers of the sea.1083

Durable nature of many of their contents.—Millions of silver dollars and other coins have been sometimes submerged in a single ship, and on these, when they happen to be enveloped in a matrix capable of protecting them from chemical changes, much information of historical interest will remain inscribed, and endure for periods as indefinite as have the delicate markings of zoophytes or lapidified plants in some of the ancient secondary rocks. In almost every large ship, moreover, there are some precious stones set in seals, and other articles of use and ornament composed of the hardest substances in nature, on which letters and various images are carved—engravings which they may retain when included in subaqueous strata, as long as a crystal preserves its natural form.

Durable nature of many of their contents.—Millions of silver dollars and other coins have sometimes been submerged in a single ship. When these coins are surrounded by a material that protects them from chemical changes, a lot of historically significant information will remain etched on them and can last for as long as the delicate markings of zoophytes or fossilized plants found in some ancient sedimentary rocks. Additionally, almost every large ship contains some precious stones set in seals and other useful and decorative items made from the hardest materials in nature, which have letters and various images carved into them—designs that can stay intact when embedded in underwater layers, just like a crystal maintains its natural shape.

It was, therefore, a splendid boast, that the deeds of the English chivalry at Agincourt made Henry's chronicle

It was, therefore, a great claim that the actions of the English knights at Agincourt made Henry's story.

as full of praise Like the sludge and floor of the deep sea With a sunken ship and countless treasures

for it is probable that a greater number of monuments of the skill and industry of man will, in the course of ages, be collected together in the bed of the ocean, than will exist at any one time on the surface of the continents.

for it is likely that more monuments showcasing human skill and effort will, over the ages, be gathered in the ocean floor than will be found at any one time on the surface of the continents.

If our species be of as recent a date as is generally supposed, it will be vain to seek for the remains of man and the works of his hands imbedded in submarine strata, except in those regions where violent earthquakes are frequent, and the alterations of relative level so great, that the bed of the sea may have been converted into land within the historical era. We need not despair, however, of the discovery of such monuments, 757 when those regions which have been peopled by man from the earliest ages, and which are at the same time the principal theatres of volcanic action, shall be examined by the joint skill of the antiquary and geologist.

If our species is as recent as people generally believe, it would be pointless to search for human remains and tools buried in underwater layers, except in areas where frequent earthquakes occur and the shifts in land levels are so significant that the ocean floor might have turned into land within recorded history. However, we shouldn't lose hope for the discovery of such artifacts, 757 especially when regions that have been inhabited by humans since ancient times, and are also major sites of volcanic activity, are examined by both archaeologists and geologists.

Power of human remains to resist decay.—There can be no doubt that human remains are as capable of resisting decay as are the harder parts of the inferior animals; and I have already cited the remark of Cuvier, that "in ancient fields of battle the bones of men have suffered as little decomposition as those of horses which were buried in the same grave." (See above, p. 147.) In the delta of the Ganges bones of men have been found in digging a well at the depth of ninety feet;1084 but as that river frequently shifts its course and fills up its ancient channels, we are not called upon to suppose that these bodies are of extremely high antiquity, or that they were buried when that part of the surrounding delta where they occur was first gained from the sea.

Power of human remains to resist decay.—There’s no doubt that human remains can resist decay just as well as the tougher parts of lower animals; I've already mentioned Cuvier's observation that "in ancient battlefields, human bones have decomposed just as little as those of horses buried in the same grave." (See above, p. 147.) In the delta of the Ganges, human bones have been discovered while digging a well at a depth of ninety feet;1084 but since that river often changes its course and fills in its old channels, we don’t have to assume that these bodies are extremely old or that they were buried when that part of the delta was first formed from the sea.

Fossil skeletons of men.—Several skeletons of men, more or less mutilated, have been found in the West Indies, on the north-west coast of the main land of Guadaloupe, in a kind of rock which is known to be forming daily, and which consists of minute fragments of shells and corals, incrusted with a calcareous cement resembling travertin, by which also the different grains are bound together. The lens shows that some of the fragments of coral composing this stone still retain the same red color which is seen in the reefs of living coral which surround the island. The shells belong to species of the neighboring sea intermixed with some terrestrial kinds which now live on the island, and among them is the Bulimus Gaudaloupensis of Férussac. The human skeletons still retain some of their animal matter, and all their phosphate of lime. One of them, of which the head is wanting, may now be seen in the British Museum, and another in the Royal Cabinet at Paris. According to M. König, the rock in which the former is inclosed is harder under the mason's saw and chisel than statuary marble. It is described as forming a kind of glacis, probably an indurated beach, which slants from the steep cliffs of the island to the sea, and is nearly all submerged at high tide.

Fossil skeletons of men.—Several skeletons of men, some of them damaged, have been found in the West Indies, on the northwest coast of mainland Guadeloupe, in a type of rock that is forming daily. This rock consists of tiny fragments of shells and corals, bonded together with a calcareous cement similar to travertine. The microscope reveals that some of the coral fragments in this stone still have the same red color seen in the reefs of living coral surrounding the island. The shells belong to species from the nearby sea, mixed with some terrestrial types that currently exist on the island, including the Bulimus Gaudaloupensis described by Férussac. The human skeletons still contain some of their organic material along with all their phosphate of lime. One of them, which is missing its head, can now be seen in the British Museum, and another is in the Royal Cabinet in Paris. According to M. König, the rock containing the first skeleton is harder under a mason's saw and chisel than statuary marble. It is described as forming a kind of slope, possibly a hardened beach, which tilts from the steep cliffs of the island down to the sea and is almost completely submerged at high tide.

Similar formations are in progress in the whole of the West Indian archipelago, and they have greatly extended the plain of Cayes in St. Domingo, where fragments of vases and other human works have been found at a depth of twenty feet. In digging wells also near Catania, in Sicily, tools have been discovered in a rock somewhat similar.

Similar formations are happening throughout the entire West Indian archipelago, and they have significantly expanded the plain of Cayes in St. Domingo, where pieces of vases and other human artifacts have been found at a depth of twenty feet. In addition, while digging wells near Catania, in Sicily, tools have been uncovered in a rock that is somewhat similar.

Buried ships, canoes, and works of art.—When a vessel is stranded in shallow water, it usually becomes the nucleus of a sand-bank, as has been exemplified in several of our harbors, and this circumstance tends greatly to its preservation. Between the years 1780 and 1790 a vessel from Purbeck, laden with three hundred tons of stone, struck on a shoal off the entrance of Poole harbor and foundered; the crew were saved, 758 but the vessel and cargo remain to this day at the bottom. Since that period the shoal at the entrance of the harbor has so extended itself in a westerly direction towards Peveril Point in Purbeck, that the navigable channel is thrown a mile nearer that point.1085 The cause is obvious; the tidal current deposits the sediment with which it is charged around any object which checks its velocity. Matter also drifted along the bottom is arrested by any obstacle, and accumulates round it, just as the African sand-winds, before described, raise a small hillock over the carcass of every dead camel exposed on the surface of the desert.

Buried ships, canoes, and works of art.—When a ship gets stuck in shallow water, it often becomes the center of a sandbank, as seen in several of our harbors, which helps preserve it. Between 1780 and 1790, a ship from Purbeck carrying three hundred tons of stone ran aground on a shoal at the entrance of Poole harbor and sank; the crew was saved, 758 but the ship and cargo are still at the bottom today. Since then, the shoal at the harbor entrance has extended westward towards Peveril Point in Purbeck, making the navigable channel a mile closer to that point.1085 The reason is clear; the tidal current drops the sediment it's carrying around anything that slows it down. Debris drifting along the bottom is also stopped by any obstacle and builds up around it, much like how the African sand winds, as previously described, create a small mound over every dead camel left exposed in the desert.

I before alluded to an ancient Dutch vessel, discovered in the deserted channel of the river Rother in Sussex, of which the oak wood was much blackened, but its texture unchanged. (See above, p. 316.) The interior was filled with fluviatile silt, as was also the case in regard to a vessel discovered in a former bed of the Mersey, and another disinterred where the St. Katherine Docks are excavated in the alluvial plain of the Thames. In like manner many ships have been found preserved entire in modern strata, formed by the silting up of estuaries along the southern shores of the Baltic, especially in Pomerania. Between Bromberg and Nakel, for example, a vessel and two anchors in a very perfect state were dug up far from the sea.1086

I previously mentioned an old Dutch ship, found in the abandoned channel of the River Rother in Sussex, which was heavily blackened but still intact in structure. (See above, p. 316.) The inside was filled with river silt, similar to a ship discovered in a former section of the Mersey, and another found where the St. Katherine Docks were dug out in the floodplain of the Thames. Similarly, many ships have been found completely intact in modern layers formed by sediment buildup in estuaries along the southern shores of the Baltic, especially in Pomerania. For instance, between Bromberg and Nakel, a ship and two anchors in excellent condition were excavated far from the sea.1086

Several vessels have been lately detected half buried in the delta of the Indus, in the numerous deserted branches of that river, far from where the stream now flows. One of these found near Vikkar in Sinde, was 400 tons in burthen, old fashioned, and pierced for fourteen guns, and in a region where it had been matter of dispute whether the Indus had ever been navigable by large vessels.1087

Several ships have recently been discovered partially buried in the delta of the Indus, in the many abandoned branches of the river, far from where the water flows today. One of these, found near Vikkar in Sindh, weighed 400 tons, had an outdated design, and was fitted for fourteen guns, in an area where there has been debate over whether the Indus was ever navigable by large vessels.1087

At the mouth of a river in Nova Scotia, a schooner of thirty-two tons, laden with live stock, was lying with her side to the tide, when the bore, or tidal wave, which rises there about ten feet in perpendicular height, rushed into the estuary, and overturned the vessel, so that it instantly disappeared. After the tide had ebbed, the schooner was so totally buried in the sand, that the taffrel or upper rail over the stern was alone visible.1088 We are informed by Leigh that, on draining Martin Meer, a lake eighteen miles in circumference, in Lancashire, a bed of marl was laid dry, wherein no fewer than eight canoes were found imbedded. In figure and dimensions they were not unlike those now used in America. In a morass about nine miles distant from this Meer a whetstone and an axe of mixed metal were dug up.1089 In Ayrshire, also, three canoes were found in Loch Doon some few years ago; and during the year 1831 four others, each hewn out of separate oak trees. They were twenty-three feet in length, two and a half in depth, and nearly four feet in breadth at the stern. In the mud which filled one of them was found a 759 war-club of oak and a stone battle-axe. A canoe of oak was also found in 1820, in peat overlying the shell-marl of the Loch of Kinnordy, in Forfarshire.1090

At the mouth of a river in Nova Scotia, a thirty-two-ton schooner, loaded with livestock, was moored sideways to the tide when the bore, or tidal wave, which rises about ten feet high, surged into the estuary and capsized the vessel, causing it to vanish instantly. Once the tide went out, the schooner was so completely buried in the sand that only the top rail at the back was visible.1088 Leigh informs us that while draining Martin Meer, a lake that spans eighteen miles, in Lancashire, a bed of marl was uncovered where no fewer than eight canoes were found embedded. They were similar in shape and size to those currently used in America. About nine miles away from this Meer, in a swamp, a whetstone and an axe made of mixed metal were excavated.1089 In Ayrshire, three canoes were discovered in Loch Doon a few years ago; and in 1831, four others, each carved from separate oak trees. They measured twenty-three feet in length, two and a half feet in depth, and nearly four feet in width at the back. In the mud that filled one of them, a wooden war club and a stone battle-axe were found. An oak canoe was also discovered in 1820, in peat resting over the shell-marl of the Loch of Kinnordy, in Forfarshire.1090

Manner in which ships may be preserved in a deep sea.—It is extremely possible that the submerged woodwork of ships which have sunk where the sea is two or three miles deep has undergone greater chemical changes in an equal space of time, than in the cases above mentioned; for the experiments of Scoresby show that wood may at certain depths be impregnated in a single hour with salt water, so that its specific gravity is entirely altered. It may often happen that hot springs, charged with carbonate of lime, silex, and other mineral ingredients, may issue at great depths, in which case every pore of the vegetable tissue may be injected with the lapidifying liquid, whether calcareous or siliceous, before the smallest decay commences. The conversion, also, of wood into lignite is probably more rapid under enormous pressure. But the change of the timber into lignite or coal would not prevent the original form of a ship from being distinguished; for as we find, in strata of the carboniferous era, the bark of the hollow reed-like trees converted into coal, and the central cavity filled with sandstone, so might we trace the outline of a ship in coal; while in the indurated mud, sandstone, or limestone, filling the interior, we might discover instruments of human art, ballast consisting of rocks foreign to the rest of the stratum, and other contents of the ship.

How to Preserve Ships in Deep Sea.—It's very likely that the submerged wood of ships that have sunk in waters two or three miles deep has undergone more chemical changes over the same period than those mentioned earlier. Scoresby's experiments show that at certain depths, wood can absorb salt water within just an hour, changing its specific gravity completely. Hot springs filled with calcium carbonate, silica, and other minerals can emerge at great depths, causing every pore of the plant material to become infused with these hardening liquids, whether they are calcareous or siliceous, before any decay begins. The process of turning wood into lignite is likely to be faster under immense pressure. However, the transformation of timber into lignite or coal wouldn’t prevent us from recognizing the original shape of a ship; as seen in carboniferous strata, where the bark of hollow, reed-like trees has turned into coal and the central cavity is filled with sandstone, we could trace the outline of a ship in coal. Inside, within the hardened mud, sandstone, or limestone, we might find tools created by humans, ballast made up of rocks not originally part of that layer, and other contents of the ship.

Submerged metallic substances.—Many of the metallic substances which fall into the waters probably lose, in the course of ages, the forms artificially imparted to them; but under certain circumstances these may be preserved for indefinite periods. The cannon enclosed in a calcareous rock, drawn up from the delta of the Rhone, which is now in the museum at Montpellier, might probably have endured as long as the calcareous matrix; but even if the metallic matter had been removed, and had entered into new combinations, still a mould of its original shape would have been left, corresponding to those impressions of shells which we see in rocks, from which all the carbonate of lime has been subtracted. About the year 1776, says Mr. King, some fishermen, sweeping for anchors in the Gulf stream (a part of the sea near the Downs), drew up a very curious old swivel gun, nearly eight feet in length. The barrel, which was about five feet long, was of brass; but the handle by which it was traversed was about three feet in length, and the swivel and pivot on which it turned were of iron. Around these latter were formed incrustations of sand converted into a kind of stone, of exceedingly strong texture and firmness; whereas round the barrel of the gun, except where it was near adjoining to the iron, there were no such incrustations, the greater part of it being clean, and in good condition, just as if it had still continued in use. In the incrusting stone, adhering to it on the outside, were a number of shells and corallines, "just as they are often found in a fossil 760 state." These were all so strongly attached, that it required as much force to separate them from the matrix "as to break a fragment off any hard rock."1091

Submerged metallic substances.—Many metallic items that end up in the water likely lose their man-made shapes over long periods, but under certain circumstances, these shapes can be preserved indefinitely. The cannon found encased in a calcareous rock from the delta of the Rhone, now in the museum at Montpellier, may have lasted as long as the rock around it. Even if the metal had disappeared and formed new compounds, a mold of its original shape would remain, similar to the impressions of shells we see in rocks after the carbonate of lime has eroded away. Around 1776, Mr. King reports that some fishermen searching for anchors in the Gulf Stream, near the Downs, discovered a fascinating old swivel gun that was nearly eight feet long. The barrel was about five feet long and made of brass, while the handle used for aiming was about three feet long, made of iron. The swivel and pivot that allowed it to turn were also iron. Sand had formed hard stone-like incrustations around these iron parts; however, around the brass barrel, there were no such incrustations except where it was close to the iron, and most of it was clean and well-preserved, as if it had been in use recently. Embedded in the incrusted stone outside were several shells and corals, "just like those often found in fossil 760 form." These shells were so securely attached that it took considerable force to remove them from the rock, "just like breaking a piece off any hard rock."1091

In the year 1745, continues the same writer, the Fox man-of-war was stranded on the coast of East Lothian, and went to pieces. About thirty-three years afterwards a violent storm laid bare a part of the wreck, and threw up near the place several masses, "consisting of iron, ropes, and balls," covered over with ochreous sand, concreted and hardened into a kind of stone. The substance of the rope was very little altered. The consolidated sand retained perfect impressions of parts of an iron ring, "just as impressions of extraneous fossil bodies are found in various kinds of strata."1092

In 1745, the same writer continues, the Fox warship got stranded on the coast of East Lothian and broke apart. About thirty-three years later, a violent storm exposed part of the wreck and washed up several pieces nearby, "made of iron, ropes, and balls," covered in ochreous sand, which had hardened into a kind of stone. The rope's material changed very little. The solidified sand kept clear impressions of parts of an iron ring, "just like impressions of fossilized objects are found in different layers of rock."1092

After a storm in the year 1824, which occasioned a considerable shifting of the sands near St. Andrew's, in Scotland, a gun-barrel of ancient construction was found, which is conjectured to have belonged to one of the wrecked vessels of the Spanish Armada. It is now in the museum of the Antiquarian Society of Scotland, and is incrusted over by a thin coating of sand, the grains of which are cemented by brown ferruginous matter. Attached to this coating are fragments of various shells, as of the common cardium, mya, &c.

After a storm in 1824, which caused a significant shift in the sands near St. Andrew's, Scotland, an old gun barrel was discovered, believed to have belonged to one of the wrecked ships from the Spanish Armada. It is now housed in the museum of the Antiquarian Society of Scotland and is covered by a thin layer of sand, with the grains cemented together by brown iron-rich material. Fragments of various shells, such as common cardium and mya, are attached to this layer.

Many other examples are recorded of iron instruments taken up from the bed of the sea near the British coast, incased by a thick coating of conglomerate, consisting of pebbles and sand, cemented by oxide of iron.

Many other examples have been documented of iron tools retrieved from the ocean floor near the British coast, surrounded by a thick layer of conglomerate made up of pebbles and sand, bonded together by iron oxide.

Dr. Davy describes a bronze helmet, of the antique Grecian form, taken up in 1825, from a shallow part of the sea, between the citadel of Corfu and the village of Castrades. Both the interior and exterior of the helmet were partially incrusted with shells, and a deposit of carbonate of lime. The surface generally, both under the incrustation, and where freed from it, was of a variegated color, mottled with spots of green, dirty white, and red. On minute inspection with a lens, the green and red patches proved to consist of crystals of the red oxide and carbonate of copper, and the dirty white chiefly of oxide of tin.

Dr. Davy describes a bronze helmet, in the ancient Greek style, retrieved in 1825 from a shallow area of the sea, between the fortress of Corfu and the village of Castrades. Both the inside and outside of the helmet were partially covered with shells and a buildup of carbonate of lime. The overall surface, both beneath the coverings and where it was cleaned off, had a mix of colors, speckled with green, dull white, and red spots. Upon close examination with a lens, the green and red patches turned out to be made of crystals of red oxide and carbonate of copper, while the dull white was mainly made up of tin oxide.

The mineralizing process, says Dr. Davy, which has produced these new combinations, has, in general, penetrated very little into the substance of the helmet. The incrustation and rust removed, the metal is found bright beneath; in some places considerably corroded, in others very slightly. It proves, on analysis, to be copper, alloyed with 18.5 per cent. of tin. Its color is that of our common brass, and it possesses a considerable degree of flexibility.

The mineralizing process, according to Dr. Davy, that created these new combinations has generally not gone deep into the material of the helmet. Once the layer of crust and rust is cleared away, the metal underneath is found to be bright; in some areas, it’s significantly corroded, while in others, it’s only slightly affected. An analysis shows it’s copper mixed with 18.5 percent tin. Its color resembles that of ordinary brass, and it has a good amount of flexibility.

"It is a curious question," he adds, "how the crystals were formed in the helmet, and on the adhering calcareous deposit. There being no reason to suppose deposition from solution, are we not under the necessity of inferring, that the mineralizing process depends on a small motion and separation of the particles of the original compound? This motion 761 may have been due to the operation of electro-chemical powers which may have separated the different metals of the alloy.1093

"It’s an interesting question," he adds, "how the crystals formed in the helmet and on the attached limestone deposit. Since there’s no reason to think it was deposited from a solution, don’t we have to conclude that the mineralization process relies on a slight movement and separation of the original compound’s particles? This movement 761 might have been caused by electro-chemical forces that separated the different metals in the alloy.1093

Effects of the Subsidence of Land, in imbedding Cities and Forests in subaqueous Strata.

We have hitherto considered the transportation of plants and animals from the land by aqueous agents, and their inhumation in lacustrine or submarine deposits, and we may now inquire what tendency the subsidence of tracts of land may have to produce analogous effects. Several examples of the sinking down of buildings, and portions of towns near the shore, to various depths beneath the level of the sea during subterranean movements, were before enumerated in treating of the changes brought about by inorganic causes. The events alluded to were comprised within a brief portion of the historical period, and confined to a small number of the regions of active volcanoes. Yet these authentic facts, relating merely to the last century and a half, gave indications of considerable changes in the physical geography of the globe, and we are not to suppose that these were the only spots throughout the surrounding land and sea which suffered similar depressions.

We have previously looked at how plants and animals are transported from land by water and buried in lake or ocean deposits. Now we can explore how the sinking of land areas might produce similar effects. We discussed several examples of buildings and parts of towns near the shore sinking to various depths below sea level during underground movements. These events were mentioned earlier when we talked about changes caused by non-living factors. The events we referenced occurred within a short time frame in the last century and a half and were limited to a small number of active volcanic regions. However, these real events indicate significant changes in the physical geography of the Earth, and we shouldn't assume that these were the only areas experiencing similar sinking in the surrounding land and sea.

If, during the short period since South America has been colonized by Europeans, we have proof of alterations of level at the three principal ports on the western shores, Callao, Valparaiso, and Conception,1094 we cannot for a moment suspect that these cities, so distant from each other, have been selected as the peculiar points where the desolating power of the earthquake has expended its chief fury. On considering how small is the area occupied by the seaports of this disturbed region—points where alone each slight change of the relative level of the sea and land can be recognized,—and reflecting on the proofs in our possession of the local revolutions that have happened on the site of each port, within the last century and a half,—our conceptions must be greatly exalted respecting the magnitude of the alterations which the country between the Andes and the sea may have undergone, even in the course of the last six thousand years.

If, during the short time since South America was colonized by Europeans, we have evidence of changes in sea level at the three main ports on the western coast—Callao, Valparaiso, and Conception,1094 we cannot for a moment believe that these cities, so far apart, have been specifically chosen as the main spots where the destructive force of earthquakes has unleashed its full power. When we consider how small the area occupied by the seaports in this affected region is—places where any small change in the relative levels of the sea and land can be noted—and reflect on the evidence we have of local events that have occurred at each port over the last century and a half, we must greatly increase our understanding of the scale of changes that the land between the Andes and the sea may have experienced, even over the last six thousand years.

Cutch earthquake.—The manner in which a large extent of surface may be submerged, so that the terrestrial plants and animals may be imbedded in subaqueous strata, cannot be better illustrated than by the earthquake of Cutch, in 1819, before alluded to (p. 460). It is stated, that, for some years after that earthquake, the withered tamarisks and other shrubs protruded their tops above the waves, in parts of the lagoon formed by subsidence, on the site of the village of Sindree and its environs; but, after the flood of 1826, they were seen no longer. Every geologist will at once perceive, that forests sunk by such subterranean movements may become imbedded in subaqueous deposits, both fluviatile 762 and marine, and the trees may still remain erect, or sometimes the roots and part of the trunks may continue in their original position, while the current may have broken off, or levelled with the ground, their upper stems and branches.

Cutch earthquake.—The way a large area of land can be submerged, causing terrestrial plants and animals to be buried under water, is best illustrated by the Cutch earthquake in 1819, mentioned earlier (p. 460). It's reported that for several years after the earthquake, dead tamarisks and other shrubs stuck their tops out of the water in parts of the lagoon formed by the land sinking, where the village of Sindree used to be; however, after the flood in 1826, they were no longer visible. Any geologist will immediately understand that forests sunk by such underground movements can become buried in underwater layers, both from rivers 762 and the sea, and the trees may still stand upright, or sometimes the roots and parts of the trunks may stay in their original positions, while the current might have broken off or leveled their upper stems and branches.

Buildings how preserved under water.—Some of the buildings which have at different times subsided beneath the level of the sea have been immediately covered up to a certain extent with strata of volcanic matter showered down upon them. Such was the case at Tomboro in Sumbawa, in the present century, and at the site of the Temple of Serapis, in the environs of Puzzuoli, probably about the 12th century. The entrance of a river charged with sediment in the vicinity may still more frequently occasion the rapid envelopment of buildings in regularly stratified formations. But if no foreign matter be introduced, the buildings, when once removed to a depth where the action of the waves is insensible, and where no great current happens to flow, may last for indefinite periods, and be as durable as the floor of the ocean itself, which may often be composed of the very same materials. There is no reason to doubt the tradition mentioned by the classic writers, that the submerged Grecian towns of Bura and Helice were seen under water; and it has been already mentioned that different eye-witnesses have observed the houses of Port Royal, at the bottom of the sea, at intervals of 88, 101, and 143 years after the convulsion of 1692. (p. 505.)

Buildings preserved underwater.—Some buildings that have submerged below sea level at different times have been quickly covered to some extent with layers of volcanic material that fell onto them. This happened at Tomboro in Sumbawa in the current century and at the site of the Temple of Serapis in the area of Puzzuoli, likely around the 12th century. The entrance of a river carrying sediment nearby can also quickly cause buildings to be buried in accurately layered formations. However, if no foreign materials are introduced, buildings that sink to a depth where wave action is negligible and where no strong currents are present can last for indefinite periods, being just as durable as the ocean floor, which may often be made up of the same materials. There is no reason to doubt the accounts mentioned by classic writers that the submerged Greek towns of Bura and Helice were visible underwater; it has already been noted that various eyewitnesses have seen the houses of Port Royal at the ocean's bottom at intervals of 88, 101, and 143 years after the earthquake in 1692. (p. 505.)

Buried temples of Cashmere.—The celebrated valley of Cashmere (or Kashmir) in India, situated at the southern foot of the Himalaya range, is about 60 miles in length, and 20 in breadth, surrounded by mountains which rise abruptly from the plain to the height of about 5000 feet. In the cliffs of the river Jelam and its tributaries, which traverse this beautiful valley, strata consisting of fine clay, sand, soft sandstone, pebbles, and conglomerate are exposed to view. They contain freshwater shells, of the genera Lymneus, Paludina, and Cyrena, with land shells, all of recent species, and are precisely such deposits as would be formed if the whole valley were now converted into a great lake, and if the numerous rivers and torrents descending from the surrounding mountains were allowed sufficient time to fill up the lake-basin with fine sediment and gravel. Fragments of pottery met with at the depth of 40 and 50 feet in this lacustrine formation show that the upper part of it at least has accumulated within the human epoch.

Buried temples of Cashmere.—The famous valley of Cashmere (or Kashmir) in India, located at the southern base of the Himalayas, is about 60 miles long and 20 miles wide. It's surrounded by mountains that rise quickly from the plains to about 5,000 feet high. The cliffs of the Jhelum River and its tributaries, which flow through this stunning valley, reveal layers of fine clay, sand, soft sandstone, pebbles, and conglomerate. These layers include freshwater shells from species like Lymnaea, Paludina, and Cyrena, as well as land shells, all of which are recent species. They represent deposits that would form if the entire valley were transformed into a large lake, allowing the many rivers and torrents from the surrounding mountains enough time to fill the lake basin with fine sediment and gravel. Pieces of pottery found at depths of 40 and 50 feet in this lakebed indicate that at least the upper part of this layer has formed during the human epoch.

Dr. Thomas Thomson, who visited Cashmere in 1848, observes that several of the lakes which still exist in the great valley, such as that near the town of Cashmere, five miles in diameter, and some others, are deeper than the adjoining river-channels, and may have been formed by subsidence during the numerous earthquakes which have convulsed that region in the course of the last 2000 years. It is also probable that the freshwater strata seen to extend far and wide over the whole of Cashmere originated not in one continuous sheet of water once occupying the entire valley, but in many lakes of limited area, formed and filled in succession. Among other proofs of such lake-basins of moderate 763 dimensions having once existed and having been converted into land at different periods, Dr. Thomson mentions that the ruins of Avantipura, not far from the modern village of that name, stand on an older freshwater deposit at the base of the mountains, and terminate abruptly towards the plain in a straight line, such as admits of no other explanation than by supposing that the advance of the town in that direction was arrested by a lake, now drained or represented only by a marsh. In that neighborhood, as very generally throughout Cashmere, the rivers run in channels or alluvial flats, bounded by cliffs of lacustrine strata, horizontally stratified, and these strata form low table-lands from 20 to 50 feet high between the different watercourses. On a table-land of this kind near Avantipura, portions of two buried temples are seen, which have been partially explored by Major Cunningham, who, in 1847, discovered that in one of the buildings a magnificent colonnade of seventy-four pillars is preserved underground. He exposed to view three of the pillars in a cavity still open. All the architectural decorations below the level of the soil are as perfect and fresh-looking as when first executed. The spacious quadrangle must have been silted up gradually at first, for some unsightly alterations, not in accordance with the general plan and style of architecture, were detected, evidently of subsequent date, and such as could only have been required when the water and sediment had already gained a certain height in the interior of the temple.

Dr. Thomas Thomson, who visited Kashmir in 1848, notes that several lakes still found in the great valley, like the one near the town of Kashmir, which is five miles in diameter, are deeper than the nearby river channels. These lakes may have been formed by sinking during the many earthquakes that have shaken the area over the last 2,000 years. It’s also likely that the freshwater layers seen spread out across Kashmir did not come from one continuous body of water that once filled the entire valley, but from many smaller lakes that were formed and filled one after another. Among other evidence of these moderately sized lake basins that once existed and were turned into land at different times, Dr. Thomson mentions that the ruins of Avantipura, not far from the modern village of the same name, sit on older freshwater deposits at the base of the mountains and end abruptly toward the plain in a straight line. This can only be explained by thinking that the city's expansion in that direction was stopped by a lake, which has now drained or is represented only by marshland. In that area, as is common throughout Kashmir, rivers flow through channels or alluvial flats, bordered by cliffs of lakebed layers that are horizontally layered. These layers create low tablelands that rise between 20 to 50 feet high between the watercourses. On one of these tablelands near Avantipura, parts of two buried temples can be seen, which have been partially explored by Major Cunningham. In 1847, he found that in one of the buildings, a stunning colonnade of seventy-four pillars is preserved underground. He uncovered three of the pillars in a still-open cavity. All the architectural decorations below the soil level are as intact and fresh-looking as when they were first made. The large courtyard must have gradually been filled with sediment at first because some unsightly changes were detected that do not fit with the overall plan and style of architecture. These changes are clearly of a later date and could only have been needed once the water and sediment had reached a certain height inside the temple.

This edifice is supposed to have been erected about the year 850 of our era, and was certainly submerged before the year 1416, when the Mahomedan king, Sikandar, called Butshikan or the idol-breaker, destroyed all the images of Hindoo temples in Cashmere. Ferishta the historian particularly alludes to Sikandar having demolished every Cashmerian temple save one, dedicated to Mahadéva, which escaped "in consequence of its foundations being below the neighboring water." The unharmed condition of the human-headed birds and other images in the buried edifice near Avantipura leaves no doubt that they escaped the fury of the iconoclast by being under water, and perhaps silted up before the date of his conquest.1095

This building is believed to have been built around the year 850 AD and was definitely submerged before 1416, when the Muslim king, Sikandar, known as Butshikan or the idol-breaker, destroyed all the images in Hindu temples in Kashmir. The historian Ferishta specifically mentions that Sikandar tore down every temple in Kashmir except for one dedicated to Mahadeva, which survived "because its foundations were beneath the surrounding water." The intact condition of the human-headed birds and other images in the submerged structure near Avantipura shows that they avoided destruction by being underwater, and possibly became buried in silt before he conquered the area.1095

Berkeley's arguments for the recent date of the creation of man.—I cannot conclude this chapter without recalling to the reader's mind a memorable passage written by Bishop Berkeley a century ago, in which he inferred, on grounds which may be termed strictly geological, the recent date of the creation of man. "To any one," says he, "who considers that on digging into the earth, such quantities of shells, and in some places, bones and horns of animals, are found sound and entire, after having lain there in all probability some thousands of years; it should seem probable that guns, medals, and implements in metal or stone, might have lasted entire, buried under ground forty or fifty 764 thousand years, if the world had been so old. How comes it then to pass that no remains are found, no antiquities of those numerous ages preceding the Scripture accounts of time; that no fragments of buildings, no public monuments, no intaglios, cameos, statues, basso-relievos, medals, inscriptions, utensils, or artificial works of any kind, are ever discovered, which may bear testimony to the existence of those mighty empires, those successions of monarchs, heroes, and demi-gods, for so many thousand years? Let us look forward and suppose ten or twenty thousand years to come, during which time we will suppose that plagues, famine, wars, and earthquakes shall have made great havoc in the world, is it not highly probable that at the end of such a period, pillars, vases, and statues now in being, of granite, or porphyry, or jasper (stones of such hardness as we know them to have lasted two thousand years above ground, without any considerable alteration), would bear record of these and past ages? Or that some of our current coins might then be dug up, or old walls and the foundations of buildings show themselves, as well as the shells and stones of the primeval world, which are preserved down to our times."1096

Berkeley's arguments for the recent date of the creation of man.—I cannot end this chapter without bringing to the reader's attention a memorable passage written by Bishop Berkeley a century ago, in which he inferred, based on what we can call strictly geological evidence, that man was created more recently. "To anyone," he says, "who considers that when digging into the earth, we find such large quantities of shells, and in some places, intact bones and horns of animals, after they have likely been there for thousands of years; it should seem likely that guns, medals, and tools made of metal or stone could also remain intact, buried underground for forty or fifty thousand years, if the world had been that old. How is it then that no remains are found, no antiquities from those numerous ages before the biblical accounts of time; that no fragments of buildings, no public monuments, no intaglios, cameos, statues, low-reliefs, medals, inscriptions, utensils, or any kind of artificial works are ever discovered that could testify to the existence of those great empires, those sequences of kings, heroes, and demigods, for so many thousands of years? Let’s look ahead and imagine ten or twenty thousand years from now, during which time we assume plagues, famine, wars, and earthquakes have caused great destruction in the world, isn’t it highly likely that at the end of such a period, pillars, vases, and statues we have today, made of granite, porphyry, or jasper (stones that we know have lasted two thousand years above ground without significant change), would record these and past ages? Or that some of our current coins might then be unearthed, or old walls and building foundations revealed, just like the shells and stones of the primeval world, which have been preserved until now."1096

That many signs of the agency of man would have lasted at least as long as "the shells of the primeval world," had our race been so ancient, we may feel as fully persuaded as Berkeley; and we may anticipate with confidence that many edifices and implements of human workmanship and the skeletons of men, and casts of the human form, will continue to exist when a great part of the present mountains, continents, and seas have disappeared. Assuming the future duration of the planet to be indefinitely protracted, we can foresee no limit to the perpetuation of some of the memorials of man, which are continually entombed in the bowels of the earth or in the bed of the ocean, unless we carry forward our views to a period sufficient to allow the various causes of change, both igneous and aqueous, to remodel more than once the entire crust of the earth. One complete revolution will be inadequate to efface every monument of our existence; for many works of art might enter again and again into the formations of successive eras, and escape obliteration even though the very rocks in which they had been for ages imbedded were destroyed, just as pebbles included in the conglomerates of one epoch often contain the organized remains of beings which flourished during a prior era.

That many signs of human activity would have lasted at least as long as "the shells of the primeval world," had our species been that ancient, we can be as convinced as Berkeley. We can confidently expect that many buildings, tools, human skeletons, and casts of the human form will still exist long after much of today’s mountains, continents, and seas have vanished. Assuming that the planet will endure for a very long time, we can see no limit to how long some of mankind's memorials, which are constantly buried in the earth or the ocean, will last, unless we extend our views far enough into the future to allow for the various causes of change, both volcanic and aquatic, to reshape the entire crust of the earth more than once. Just one complete cycle won’t be enough to erase every monument of our existence; many works of art might repeatedly become part of the formations of different eras and escape destruction, even if the very rocks they've been embedded in for ages are gone, just like pebbles found in the conglomerates of one epoch often include the fossilized remains of creatures that thrived in an earlier time.

Yet it is no less true, as a late distinguished philosopher has declared, "that none of the works of a mortal being can be eternal."1097 They are in the first place wrested from the hands of man, and lost as far as regards their subserviency to his use, by the instrumentality of those very causes which place them in situations where they are enabled to endure for indefinite periods. And even when they have been included in rocky strata, when they have been made to enter as it were into the solid frame 765work of the globe itself, they must nevertheless eventually perish; for every year some portion of the earth's crust is shattered by earthquakes, or melted by volcanic fire, or ground to dust by the moving waters on the surface. "The river of Lethe," as Bacon eloquently remarks, "runneth as well above ground as below."1098

Yet it is just as true, as a recent distinguished philosopher has stated, "that none of the works of a mortal being can be eternal."1097 They are, firstly, taken from human hands and ultimately lost in terms of their usefulness, due to the very factors that allow them to last for indefinite periods. Even when they are embedded in rocky layers, as if integrated into the solid structure of the Earth itself, they must still eventually decay; for every year, some part of the Earth's crust is broken apart by earthquakes, melted by volcanic activity, or ground to dust by the moving waters on the surface. "The river of Lethe," as Bacon eloquently remarks, "runs as well above ground as below."1098


CHAPTER XLIX.

IMBEDDING OF AQUATIC SPECIES IN SUBAQUEOUS STRATA.

Inhumation of fresh water plants and animals—Shell marl—Fossilized seed-vessels and stems of chara—Recent deposits in American lakes—Freshwater species drifted into seas and estuaries—Lewes levels—Alternations of marine and freshwater strata, how caused—Imbedding of marine plants and animals—Cetacea stranded on our shores—Littoral and estuary Testacea swept into the deep sea—Burrowing shells—Living Testacea found at considerable depths—Blending of organic remains of different ages.

Inhumation of freshwater plants and animals—Shell marl—Fossilized seed vessels and stems of chara—Recent deposits in American lakes—Freshwater species that drifted into seas and estuaries—Lewes levels—Alternating marine and freshwater layers, how they formed—Embedding of marine plants and animals—Cetaceans washed up on our shores—Littoral and estuary testacea carried into the deep sea—Burrowing shells—Living testacea found at significant depths—Mixing of organic remains from different ages.

Having treated of the imbedding of terrestrial plants and animals, and of human remains, in deposits now forming beneath the waters, I come next to consider in what manner aquatic species may be entombed in strata formed in their own element.

Having discussed how land plants, animals, and human remains get embedded in deposits that are currently forming underwater, I will now look at how aquatic species can be buried in layers that form in their own environment.

Freshwater plants and animals.—The remains of species belonging to those genera of the animal and vegetable kingdoms which are more or less exclusively confined to fresh water are for the most part preserved in the beds of lakes or estuaries, but they are oftentimes swept down by rivers into the sea, and there intermingled with the exuviæ of marine races. The phenomena attending their inhumation in lacustrine deposits are sometimes revealed to our observation by the drainage of small lakes, such as are those in Scotland, which have been laid dry for the sake of obtaining shell marl for agricultural uses.

Freshwater plants and animals.—The remains of species from those groups of animals and plants that mainly live in fresh water are mostly found in the sediments of lakes or estuaries. However, they are often carried down by rivers into the ocean, where they mix with the remains of marine species. The processes involved in their burial in lake deposits can sometimes be observed when small lakes, like those in Scotland, are drained to collect shell marl for farming purposes.

In these recent formations, as seen in Forfarshire, two or three beds of calcareous marl are sometimes observed separated from each other by layers of drift peat, sand, or fissile clay. The marl often consists almost entirely of an aggregate of shells of the genera Limnea, Planorbis, Valvata, and Cyclas, of species now existing in Scotland. A considerable proportion of the Testacea appear to have died very young, and few of the shells are of a size which indicates their having attained a state of maturity. The shells are sometimes entirely decomposed, forming a pulverulent marl; sometimes in a state of good preservation. They are frequently intermixed with stems of Charæ and other aquatic vegetables, the whole being matted together and compressed, forming laminæ often as thin as paper.

In these recent deposits, like those found in Forfarshire, you can often see two or three layers of calcareous marl separated by sections of drift peat, sand, or brittle clay. The marl usually consists almost entirely of a mix of shells from the genera Limnea, Planorbis, Valvata, and Cyclas, which are species still found in Scotland today. A significant number of the Testacea appear to have died young, and few of the shells are large enough to suggest they reached maturity. Some shells are completely decomposed, turning into a powdery marl; others are well-preserved. They are often mixed with stems of Charæ and other aquatic plants, all matted together and compressed, creating layers that can be as thin as paper.

766 Fossilized seed-vessels and stems of Chara.—As the Chara is an aquatic plant which occurs frequently fossil in formations of different eras, and is often of much importance to the geologist in characterizing entire groups of strata, I shall describe the manner in which I have found the recent species in a petrified state. They occur in a marl-lake in Forfarshire, inclosed in nodules, and sometimes in a continuous stratum of a kind of travertin.

766 Fossilized seed-vessels and stems of Chara.—Since Chara is an aquatic plant that often appears as a fossil in formations from various eras and is important for geologists in identifying whole groups of rock layers, I will describe how I have found the current species in a fossilized state. They can be found in a marl lake in Forfarshire, encased in nodules and sometimes in a continuous layer of a type of travertine.

Fig. 102.Seed-vessel of Chara hispida.

Seed-vessel of Chara hispida.

Seed pod of Chara hispida.

a, Part of the stem with the seed-vessel attached. Magnified.

a, A section of the stem where the seed pod is connected. Magnified.

b, Natural size of the seed vessel.

b, Natural size of the seed pod.

c, Integument of the Gyrogonite, or petrified seed-vessel of Chara hispida, found in the Scotch marl-lakes. Magnified.

c, Integument of the Gyrogonite, or fossilized seed vessel of Chara hispida, found in the Scotch marl-lakes. Magnified.

d, Section showing the nut within the integument.

d, Section showing the nut inside the outer covering.

e, Lower end of the integument to which the stem was attached.

e, The lower part of the skin where the stem was connected.

f, Upper end of the integument to which the stigmata were attached.

f, Upper part of the skin where the openings were connected.

g, One of the spiral valves of c.

g, One of the spiral valves of c.

The seed-vessel of these plants is remarkably tough and hard, and consists of a membranous nut covered by an integument (d, fig. 102.) both of which are spirally striated or ribbed. The integument is composed of five spiral valves, of a quadrangular form (g). In Chara hispida, which abounds in the lakes of Forfarshire, and which has become fossil in the Bakie Loch, each of the spiral valves of the seed-vessel turns rather more than twice round the circumference, the whole together making between ten and eleven rings. The number of these rings differs greatly in different species, but in the same appears to be very constant.

The seed vessel of these plants is really tough and hard, made up of a membrane-like nut covered by a skin (d, fig. 102.) Both parts are wrapped with spiral striations or ribs. The skin has five spiral valves shaped like squares (g). In Chara hispida, which is common in the lakes of Forfarshire and has become fossilized in Bakie Loch, each spiral valve of the seed vessel wraps around the circumference more than twice, resulting in a total of about ten to eleven rings. The number of these rings varies widely among different species, but it seems to remain very consistent within the same species.

The stems of Charæ occur fossil in the Scotch marl in great abundance. In some species, as in Chara hispida, the plant when living contains so much carbonate of lime in its vegetable organization, independently of calcareous incrustation, that it effervesces strongly with acids when dry. The stems of Chara hispida are longitudinally striated, with a tendency to be spiral. These striæ, as appears to be the case with all Charæ, turn always like the worm of a screw from right to left, while those of the seed-vessel wind round in a contrary direction. A cross section of the stem exhibits a curious structure, for it is composed 767 of a large tube surrounded by smaller tubes (fig. 103., b, c) as is seen in some extinct as well as recent species. In the stems of several species, however, there is only a single tube.1099

The stems of Charæ are commonly found as fossils in Scotch marl. In some species, like Chara hispida, the living plant has a lot of carbonate of lime in its structure, apart from any calcareous crust, which causes it to fizz strongly when dry and exposed to acids. The stems of Chara hispida have longitudinal stripes and tend to be spiral. These stripes, like those of all Charæ, always twist from right to left, while the stripes on the seed vessel twist in the opposite direction. A cross-section of the stem shows an interesting structure, as it consists of a large tube surrounded by smaller tubes (fig. 103., b, c), similar to some extinct and recent species. However, in the stems of several species, there is only a single tube.1099

Fig. 103.Stem and branches of Chara hispida.

Stem and branches of Chara hispida.

Stem and branches of Chara hispida.

a, Stem and branches of the natural size.
b, Section of the stem magnified.
c, Showing the central tube surrounded by two rings of smaller tubes.

a, Stem and branches at their actual size.
b, Cross-section of the stem enlarged.
c, Illustrating the central tube encircled by two rings of smaller tubes.

The valves of a small animal called cypris (C. ornata? Lam.) occur completely fossilized, like the stems of Charæ, in the Scotch travertin above mentioned. The same cypris inhabits the lakes and ponds of England, where, together with many other species, it is not uncommon. Although extremely minute, they are visible to the naked eye, and may be observed in great numbers, swimming swiftly through the waters of our stagnant pools and ditches. The antennæ, at the end of which are fine pencils of hair, are the principal organs for swimming, and are moved with great rapidity. The animal resides within two small valves, not unlike those of a bivalve shell, and moults its integuments annually, which the conchiferous mollusks do not. The cast-off shells, resembling thin scales, and occurring in countless myriads in many ancient freshwater marls, impart to them a divisional structure, like that so frequently derived from plates of mica.

The valves of a small creature called cypris (C. ornata? Lam.) are completely fossilized, similar to the stems of Charæ, in the previously mentioned Scotch travertine. This cypris lives in the lakes and ponds of England, where it is quite common alongside many other species. Even though they are extremely tiny, they can be seen with the naked eye and can be observed in large numbers swimming swiftly through the waters of our stagnant pools and ditches. The antennae, which have fine tufts of hair at their ends, are the main organs used for swimming and move very quickly. The creature lives inside two small valves that resemble those of a bivalve shell, and it sheds its outer layer each year, unlike conchiferous mollusks. The discarded shells, which look like thin scales and can be found in vast numbers in many ancient freshwater marls, give them a layered structure similar to that often seen with mica plates.

Fig. 104.Cypris unifasciata
Fig. 105.Cypris vidua

Cypris unifasciata, a living species, greatly magnified.
a, Upper part. . . . b, Side view of the same.

Cypris unifasciata, a living species, greatly magnified.
a, Upper part. . . . b, Side view of the same.

Cypris vidua, a living species, greatly magnified.1100

Cypris vidua, a living species, greatly magnified.1100

The recent strata of lacustrine origin above alluded to are of very small extent, but analogous deposits on the grandest scale are forming in the great Canadian lakes, as in Lakes Superior and Huron, where beds 768 of sand and clay are seen inclosing shells of existing species.1101 The Chara also plays the same part in the subaqueous vegetation of North America as in Europe. I observed along the borders of several freshwater lakes in the state of New York a luxuriant crop of this plant in clear water of moderate depth, rendering the bottom as verdant as a grassy meadow. Here, therefore, we may expect some of the tough seed vessels to be preserved in mud, just as we detect them fossil in the Eocene strata of Hampshire, or in the neighborhood of Paris, and many other countries.

The recent layers of lake-origin deposits mentioned earlier are quite small, but similar deposits on a much larger scale are forming in the great Canadian lakes, like Lakes Superior and Huron, where layers of sand and clay contain shells of current species.768 The Chara also serves the same role in the underwater vegetation of North America as it does in Europe. I noticed along the shores of several freshwater lakes in New York a rich growth of this plant in clear water of moderate depth, making the bottom look as green as a grassy meadow. Therefore, we can expect some of the tough seed pods to be preserved in the mud, just like we find them as fossils in the Eocene layers of Hampshire, around Paris, and in many other places.

Imbedding of freshwater Species in Estuary and Marine Deposits.

In Lewes levels.—We have sometimes an opportunity of examining the deposits which within the historical period have silted up some of our estuaries; and excavations made for wells and other purposes, where the sea has been finally excluded, enable us to observe the state of the organic remains in these tracts. The valley of the Ouze between Newhaven and Lewes is one of several estuaries from which the sea has retired within the last seven or eight centuries; and here, as appears from the researches of Dr. Mantell, strata thirty feet and upwards in thickness have accumulated. At the top, beneath the vegetable soil, is a bed of peat about five feet thick, inclosing many trunks of trees. Next below is a stratum of blue clay containing freshwater shells of about nine species, such as now inhabit the district. Intermixed with these was observed the skeleton of a deer. Lower down, the layers of blue clay contain, with the above-mentioned freshwater shells, several marine species well known on our coast. In the lowest beds, often at the depth of thirty-six feet; these marine Testacea occur without the slightest intermixture of fluviatile species, and amongst them the skull of the narwal, or sea unicorn (Monodon monoceros), has been detected. Underneath all these deposits is a bed of pipe-clay, derived from the subjacent chalk.1102

In Lewes levels.—We sometimes have the chance to look at the sediments that have filled up some of our estuaries over historical times. Excavations for wells and other purposes, where the sea has been completely cut off, allow us to see the condition of the organic remains in these areas. The valley of the Ouze between Newhaven and Lewes is one of several estuaries from which the sea has retreated in the last seven or eight centuries. Here, as shown by Dr. Mantell's research, layers over thirty feet thick have built up. At the top, beneath the layer of soil, there is a peat bed about five feet thick, containing many tree trunks. Below that, there is a layer of blue clay that holds freshwater shells from about nine species that still live in the area today. Mixed in with these, the skeleton of a deer was found. Further down, the layers of blue clay contain, along with the mentioned freshwater shells, several marine species that are well known along our coast. In the deepest layers, often at a depth of thirty-six feet, these marine shells appear without any freshwater species mixed in, among which the skull of the narwhal, or sea unicorn (Monodon monoceros), has been discovered. Beneath all these layers lies a bed of pipe-clay, sourced from the underlying chalk.1102

769 If we had no historical information respecting the former existence of an inlet of the sea in this valley and of its gradual obliteration, the inspection of the section above described would show, as clearly as a written chronicle, the following sequence of events. First, there was a salt-water estuary peopled for many years by species of marine Testacea identical with those now living, and into which some of the larger Cetacea occasionally entered. Secondly, the inlet grew shallower, and the water became brackish, or alternately salt and fresh, so that the remains of freshwater and marine shells were mingled in the blue argillaceous sediment of its bottom. Thirdly, the shoaling continued until the river-water prevailed, so that it was no longer habitable by marine Testacea, but fitted only for the abode of fluviatile species and aquatic insects. Fourthly, a peaty swamp or morass was formed, where some trees grew, or perhaps were drifted during floods, and where terrestrial quadrupeds were mired. Finally, the soil being flooded by the river only at distant intervals, became a verdant meadow.

769 If we didn't have any historical knowledge about the past presence of a sea inlet in this valley and how it gradually disappeared, examining the section described above would reveal, as clearly as any written history, the following chain of events. First, there was a saltwater estuary inhabited for many years by marine shellfish identical to those that exist today, with some larger whales occasionally entering. Second, the inlet became shallower, and the water turned brackish, with a mix of salt and fresh water, resulting in both freshwater and marine shells blending in the blue clay sediment at the bottom. Third, the water continued to shallow until river water dominated, making it uninhabitable for marine shellfish but suitable for freshwater species and aquatic insects. Fourth, a peaty swamp formed, where some trees grew, or perhaps were washed in during floods, and where land animals became stuck. Finally, with the river flooding the soil only at rare intervals, it transformed into a lush meadow.

In delta of Ganges and Indus.—It was before stated, that on the sea-coast, in the delta of the Ganges, there are eight great openings, each of which has evidently, at some ancient period, served in its turn as the principal channel of discharge.1103 As the base of the delta is 200 miles in length, it must happen that, as often as the great volume of river-water is thrown into the sea by a new mouth, the sea will at one point be converted from salt to fresh, and at another from fresh to salt; for, with the exception of those parts where the principal discharge takes place, the salt water not only washes the base of the delta, but enters far into every creek and lagoon. It is evident, then, that repeated alternations of beds containing freshwater shells, with others filled with marine exuviæ, may here be formed. It has also been shown by artesian borings at Calcutta (see above, p. 267), that the delta once extended much farther than now into the gulf, and that the river is only recovering from the sea the ground which had been lost by subsidence at some former period. Analogous phenomena must sometimes be occasioned by such alternate elevation and depression as has occurred in modern times in the delta of the Indus.1104 But the subterranean movements affect but a small number of the deltas formed at one period on the globe; whereas the silting up of some of the arms of great rivers and the opening of others, and the consequent variation of the points where the chief volume of their waters is discharged into the sea, are phenomena common to almost every delta.

In the delta of the Ganges and Indus.—It has been noted that along the coastline, in the delta of the Ganges, there are eight main openings, each of which has clearly, at some point in ancient times, served as the primary channel for the river’s discharge.1103 Since the base of the delta is 200 miles long, it often happens that whenever a large volume of river water is sent into the sea through a new mouth, the sea will become fresh at one location and salty at another. Except for the areas where the main discharge occurs, the saltwater not only washes over the delta's base but also intrudes deep into every creek and lagoon. It’s clear, then, that repeated layers of sediment containing freshwater shells can alternately be found alongside layers filled with marine remains. Artesian drilling in Calcutta has also revealed (see above, p. 267) that the delta once extended much farther into the gulf than it does now, indicating that the river is reclaiming land from the sea that was lost due to subsidence in the past. Similar events must sometimes be caused by the alternating uplift and sinking that has occurred in modern times in the delta of the Indus.1104 However, underground movements impact only a few of the deltas formed at one time globally; meanwhile, the silting up of some river branches and the opening of others, along with the resulting shifts in where the main volume of their waters is discharged into the sea, are phenomena commonly seen in nearly every delta.

The variety of species of Testacea contained in the recent calcareous marl of Scotland, before mentioned, is very small, but the abundance of individuals extremely great, a circumstance very characteristic of freshwater formations in general, as compared to marine; for in the latter, as is seen on sea-beaches, coral-reefs, or in the bottom of the seas examined by dredging, wherever the individual shells are exceedingly numerous, there rarely fails to be a vast variety of species.

The range of Testacea species found in the recent calcareous marl of Scotland, as mentioned earlier, is quite limited, but the number of individuals is very large. This is typical of freshwater environments when compared to marine ones. In marine settings, as observed on beaches, coral reefs, or in the seabed explored by dredging, when individual shells are incredibly abundant, there's usually a wide variety of species present.

Imbedding of the Remains of Marine Plants and Animals.

Marine plants.—The large banks of drift sea-weed which occur on each side of the equator in the Atlantic, Pacific, and Indian oceans, were before alluded to.1105 These, when they subside, may often produce considerable beds of vegetable matter. In Holland, sub-marine peat is derived from Fuci, and on parts of our own coast from Zostera marina. In places where Algæ do not generate peat, they may nevertheless leave traces of their form imprinted on argillaceous and calcareous mud, as they are usually very tough in their texture.

Marine plants.—The large banks of drift seaweed that appear on either side of the equator in the Atlantic, Pacific, and Indian oceans were mentioned earlier.1105 When these seaweeds break down, they can create significant deposits of organic matter. In Holland, underwater peat is formed from Fuci, and along parts of our own coast from Zostera marina. In areas where algae don't produce peat, they can still leave imprints of their shape on clay and limestone mud because they are generally very durable.

Sea-weeds are often cast up in such abundance on our shores during heavy gales, that we cannot doubt that occasionally vast numbers of them are imbedded in littoral deposits now in progress. We learn from the researches of Dr. Forchhammer, that besides supplying in common with land plants the materials of coal, the Algæ must give rise to important chemical changes in the composition of strata in which they are imbedded. These plants always contain sulphuric acid, and sometimes in as large a quantity as 8½ per cent., combined with potash: magnesia also and phosphoric acid are constant ingredients. Whenever large masses of sea-weeds putrefy in contact with ferruginous clay, sulphuret of iron, or iron pyrites, is formed by the union of the sulphur of the plants with the iron of the clay; while the potash, released from its union with the clay (i. e. silicate of alumina), forms with it a peculiar compound. Many of the mineral characteristics of ancient rocks, especially the alum slates, and the pyrites which occur in clay slate, and the fragments of anthracite in marine Silurian strata, may be explained by the decomposition of fucoids or sea-weeds.1106

Seaweeds often wash up in such large quantities on our shores during heavy storms that we can’t doubt that huge amounts of them are sometimes buried in the sediment that’s currently forming. From Dr. Forchhammer’s research, we learn that, like land plants, algae also contribute to the materials that form coal and must cause significant chemical changes in the layers where they’re buried. These plants always contain sulfuric acid, and sometimes as much as 8½ percent of it, mixed with potash; magnesia and phosphoric acid are also constant components. Whenever large amounts of seaweed decompose in contact with iron-rich clay, sulfide of iron, or iron pyrites is created from the interaction of the plant’s sulfur with the iron in the clay; meanwhile, the potash, released from its bond with the clay (i.e., silicate of alumina), generates a unique compound with it. Many of the mineral traits of ancient rocks, especially alum slates, and the pyrites found in clay slate, along with bits of anthracite in marine Silurian layers, can be explained by the breakdown of fucoids or seaweeds.1106

Imbedding of cetacea.—It is not uncommon for the larger Cetacea, which can float only in a considerable depth of water, to be carried during storms or high tides into estuaries, or upon low shores, where, upon the retiring of high water, they are stranded. Thus a narwal (Monodon monoceros) was found on the beach, near Boston in Lincolnshire, in the year 1800, the whole of its body buried in the mud. A fisherman going to his boat saw the horn, and tried to pull it out, when the animal began to stir itself.1107 An individual of the common whale (Balæna) mysticetus), which measured seventy feet, came ashore near Peterhead, in 1682. Many individuals of the genus Balænoptera have met the same fate. It will be sufficient to refer to those cast on shore near Burnt Island, and at Alloa, recorded by Sibbald and Neill. The other individual mentioned by Sibbald, as having come ashore at Boyne, in Banffshire, was probably a razor-back. Of the genus Catodon (Cachalot), Ray mentions a large one stranded on the west coast of Holland in 1598, and the fact is also commemorated in a Dutch engraving of the time of much merit. Sibbald, too, records that a herd of Cachalots, upwards of 100 in number, 771 were found stranded at Cairston, in Orkney. The dead bodies of the larger Cetacea are sometimes found floating on the surface of the waters, as was the case with the immense whale exhibited in London in 1831. And the carcase of a sea-cow or Lamantine (Halicora) was, in 1785, cast ashore near Leith.

Stranding of cetaceans.—It’s not unusual for larger cetaceans, which can only float in deep water, to be swept into estuaries or along low shores during storms or high tides, where they become stranded as the water recedes. For example, a narwhal (Monodon monoceros) was found on the beach near Boston in Lincolnshire in 1800, with its entire body buried in the mud. A fisherman going to his boat noticed the horn and tried to pull it out, at which point the animal began to move.1107 An individual of the common whale (Balæna mysticetus), measuring seventy feet, came ashore near Peterhead in 1682. Many individuals from the genus Balænoptera have met a similar fate. It’s enough to mention those washed ashore near Burnt Island and Alloa, as documented by Sibbald and Neill. The other individual Sibbald mentioned, which came ashore at Boyne in Banffshire, was likely a razor-back. Ray noted a large member of the genus Catodon (Cachalot) that was stranded on the west coast of Holland in 1598, a fact also captured in a notable Dutch engraving from that time. Sibbald also recorded that a group of over 100 cachalots were found stranded at Cairston in Orkney. The carcasses of larger cetaceans are sometimes found floating on the surface of the water, as was the case with the enormous whale displayed in London in 1831. Additionally, the carcass of a sea cow or lamantine (Halicora) was cast ashore near Leith in 1785.

To some accident of this kind we may refer the position of the skeleton of a whale, seventy-three feet long, which was found at Airthrey, on the Forth, near Stirling, imbedded in clay twenty feet higher than the surface of the highest tide of the river Forth at the present day. From the situation of the Roman station and causeways at a small distance from the spot, it is concluded that the whale must have been stranded there at a period prior to the Christian era.1108

To some accident of this kind, we can explain the discovery of a 73-foot-long whale skeleton found at Airthrey, on the Forth, near Stirling, embedded in clay 20 feet higher than the current highest tide of the River Forth. Given the location of the Roman station and causeways not far from the area, it's concluded that the whale must have been stranded there before the Christian era.1108

Other fossil remains of this class have also been found in estuaries known to have been silted up in recent times, one example of which has been already mentioned near Lewes, in Sussex.

Other fossil remains from this class have also been discovered in estuaries that are known to have become silted up recently, one example of which has already been mentioned near Lewes in Sussex.

Marine reptiles.—Some singular fossils have lately been discovered in the Island of Ascension, in a stone said to be Fig. 106.Fossil eggs of turtles from the Island of Ascension. Fossil eggs of turtles from the Island of Ascension.1109 continually forming on the beach, where the waves threw up small rounded fragments of shells and corals, which, in the course of time, become firmly agglutinated together, and constitute a stone used largely for building and making lime. In a quarry on the N. W. side of the island, about 100 yards from the sea, some fossil eggs of turtles have been discovered in the hard rock thus formed. The eggs must have been nearly hatched at the time when they perished; for the bones of the young turtle are seen in the interior, with their shape fully developed, the interstices between the bones being entirely filled with grains of sand, which are cemented together, so that when the egg-shells are removed perfect casts of their form remain in stone. In the single specimen here figured (fig. 106), which is only five inches in its longest diameter, no less than seven eggs are preserved.1110

Marine reptiles.—Recently, some unique fossils were found on Ascension Island, embedded in a stone that is Fig. 106.Fossil turtle eggs from the Island of Ascension. Fossil turtle eggs from the Island of Ascension.1109 constantly being formed on the beach, where the waves pile up small rounded bits of shells and corals, which over time, get cemented together, creating a stone used extensively for building and making lime. In a quarry on the northwest side of the island, about 100 yards from the shore, some fossil turtle eggs have been found in the dense rock that formed in this way. The eggs were likely close to hatching when they died; because the bones of the young turtle are visible inside, fully formed, with the spaces between the bones completely filled with grains of sand, which are cemented together, so that when the egg shells are removed, perfect impressions of their shape remain in stone. In the single specimen shown here (fig. 106), which measures only five inches at its longest diameter, seven eggs are preserved.1110

To explain the state in which they occur fossil, it seems necessary to suppose that after the eggs were almost hatched in the warm sand, a great wave threw upon them so much more sand as to prevent the rays of the sun from penetrating, so that the yolk was chilled and deprived of 772 vitality. The shells were, perhaps, slightly broken at the same time, so that small grains of sand might gradually be introduced into the interior by water as it percolated through the beach.

To explain how fossils form, we need to assume that after the eggs were nearly hatched in the warm sand, a huge wave covered them with so much sand that sunlight couldn’t reach them, causing the yolk to cool and lose its vitality. The shells may have been slightly cracked at that point, allowing small grains of sand to slowly enter the inside as water filtered through the beach. 772

Fig. 107. One of the eggs in fig. 106, of the natural size, showing the bones of the fœtus which had been nearly hatched.

One of the eggs in fig. 106, of the natural size, showing the bones of the fœtus which had been nearly hatched.

One of the eggs in fig. 106, at its actual size, showing the bones of the fetus that had nearly hatched.

Marine testacea.—The aquatic animals and plants which inhabit an estuary are liable, like the trees and land animals which people the alluvial plains of a great river, to be swept from time to time far into the deep; for as a river is perpetually shifting its course, and undermining a portion of its banks with the forests which cover them, so the marine current alters its direction from time to time, and bears away the banks of sand and mud against which it turns its force. These banks may consist in great measure of shells peculiar to shallow and sometimes brackish water, which may have been accumulating for centuries, until at length they are carried away and spread out along the bottom of the sea, at a depth at which they could not have lived and multiplied. Thus littoral and estuary shells are more frequently liable even than freshwater species, to be intermixed with the exuviæ of pelagic tribes.

Marine testacea.—The aquatic animals and plants that live in an estuary, like the trees and land animals that populate the alluvial plains of a major river, can be occasionally washed far into the depths. Just as a river constantly changes its course and erodes parts of its banks along with the forests that grow there, marine currents also shift direction from time to time, carrying away the banks of sand and mud against which they push. These banks may largely consist of shells specific to shallow and sometimes brackish water, which may have been accumulating for centuries, only to be eventually washed away and spread across the sea floor at depths where those species couldn't have lived and reproduced. Therefore, littoral and estuary shells are even more likely than freshwater species to become mixed with the remnants of open water species.

After the storm of February 4, 1831, when several vessels were wrecked in the estuary of the Forth, the current was directed against a bed of oysters with such force, that great heaps of them were thrown alive upon the beach, and remained above high-water mark. I collected many of these oysters, as also the common eatable whelks (Buccina), thrown up with them, and observed that, although still living, their shells were worn by the long attrition of sand which had passed over them as they lay in their native bed, and which had evidently not resulted from the mere action of the tempest by which they were cast ashore.

After the storm on February 4, 1831, when several ships were wrecked in the Forth estuary, the current pushed against a bed of oysters with such force that large piles of them were thrown alive onto the beach and left above the high-water line. I collected many of these oysters, along with the common edible whelks (Buccina) that were washed up with them. I noticed that, although they were still alive, their shells were worn down from the long rubbing against the sand while they were in their natural bed, which clearly wasn't just due to the storm that washed them ashore.

From these facts we learn that the union of the two parts of a bivalve shell does not prove that it has not been transported to a distance; and 773 when we find shells worn, and with all their prominent parts rubbed off, they may still have been imbedded where they grew.

From these facts, we understand that the joining of the two halves of a bivalve shell doesn’t mean it hasn’t been moved a great distance; and 773 when we discover shells that are worn down and with all their noticeable features rubbed off, they could still have been embedded where they originally grew.

Burrowing shells.—It sometimes appears extraordinary, when we observe the violence of the breakers on our coast, and see the strength of the current in removing cliffs, and sweeping out new channels, that many tender and fragile shells should inhabit the sea in the immediate vicinity of this turmoil. But a great number of the bivalve Testacea, and many also of the turbinated univalves, burrow in sand or mud. The Solen and the Cardium, for example, which are usually found in shallow water near the shore, pierce through a soft bottom without injury to their shells; and the Pholas can drill a cavity through mud of considerable hardness. The species of these and many other tribes can sink, when alarmed, with considerable rapidity, often to the depth of several feet, and can also penetrate upwards again to the surface, if a mass of matter be heaped upon them. The hurricane, therefore, may expend its fury in vain, and may sweep away even the upper part of banks of sand or mud, or may roll pebbles over them, and yet these Testacea may remain below secure and uninjured.

Burrowing shells.—It can seem surprising when we watch the force of the waves on our shore and notice how strong the currents are at eroding cliffs and carving out new channels, that so many delicate and fragile shells live in the sea right in the middle of this chaos. However, a large number of bivalve mollusks and many species of spiraled snails actually burrow into sand or mud. For instance, the Solen and the Cardium, which are typically found in shallow waters near the beach, can push through soft bottoms without damaging their shells; the Pholas can even drill a hole through quite hard mud. These and several other species can quickly sink when startled, often diving down several feet, and can also burrow back up to the surface if debris piles on top of them. So, the raging storm may unleash its strength in vain, erasing the top layers of sand or mud banks, or rolling stones over them, yet these mollusks can stay hidden and safe below.

Shells become fossil at considerable depths.—I have already stated that, at the depth of 950 fathoms, between Gibraltar and Ceuta, Captain Smith found a gravelly bottom, with fragments of broken shells, carried thither probably from the comparatively shallow parts of the neighboring straits, through which a powerful current flows. Beds of shelly sand might here, in the course of ages, be accumulated several thousand feet thick. But, without the aid of the drifting power of a current, shells may accumulate in the spot where they live and die, at great depths from the surface, if sediment be thrown down upon them; for even in our own colder latitudes, the depths at which living marine animals abound is very considerable. Captain Vidal ascertained, by soundings made off Tory Island, on the northwest coast of Ireland, that Crustacea, Star-fish, and Testacea occurred at various depths between fifty and one hundred fathoms; and he drew up Dentalia from the mud of Galway Bay, in 230 and 240 fathoms water.

Shells turn into fossils at significant depths.—I have already mentioned that, at a depth of 950 fathoms, between Gibraltar and Ceuta, Captain Smith discovered a gravelly bottom with bits of broken shells, likely brought there from the relatively shallow areas of the nearby straits by a strong current. Over time, layers of shelly sand could build up here to several thousand feet thick. However, without the movement of a current, shells can accumulate where they live and die, even at great depths, if sediment settles on top of them; because even in our colder regions, marine animals live at considerable depths. Captain Vidal found, through soundings made off Tory Island on the northwest coast of Ireland, that Crustacea, Starfish, and Testacea existed at various depths between fifty and one hundred fathoms; he also retrieved Dentalia from the mud of Galway Bay at 230 and 240 fathoms deep.

The same hydrographer discovered on the Rockhall Bank large quantities of shells at depths varying from 45 to 190 fathoms. The shells were for the most part pulverized, and evidently recent, as they retained their colors. In the same region a bed of fish bones was observed extending for two miles along the bottom of the sea in eighty and ninety fathoms water. At the eastern extremity also of Rockhall Bank, fishbones were met with, mingled with pieces of fresh shell, at the depth of 235 fathoms.

The same hydrographer found large amounts of shells on the Rockhall Bank at depths ranging from 45 to 190 fathoms. Most of the shells were crushed and looked fresh, as they still had their colors. In that same area, a layer of fish bones stretched for two miles along the sea floor in 80 to 90 fathoms of water. At the eastern end of Rockhall Bank, fish bones were also found mixed with bits of fresh shell at a depth of 235 fathoms.

Analogous formations are in progress in the submarine tracts extending from the Shetland Isles to the north of Ireland, wherever soundings can be procured. A continuous deposit of sand and mud, replete with broken and entire shells, Echini, &c., has been traced for upwards of twenty miles to the eastward of the Faroe Islands, usually at the depth of from forty to one hundred fathoms. In one part of this tract (lat. 774 61° 50', long. 6° 30') fish-bones occur in extraordinary profusion, so that the lead cannot be drawn up without some vertebræ being attached. This "bone bed," as it was called by our surveyors, is three miles and a half in length, and forty-five fathoms under water, and contains a few shells intermingled with the bones.

Similar formations are happening in the underwater areas stretching from the Shetland Islands to the north of Ireland, wherever soundings can be taken. A continuous layer of sand and mud, filled with broken and whole shells, sea urchins, etc., has been found for over twenty miles to the east of the Faroe Islands, usually at depths of forty to one hundred fathoms. In one section of this area (lat. 774 61° 50', long. 6° 30'), fish bones are found in such abundance that the lead cannot be pulled up without some vertebrae being attached. This "bone bed," as our surveyors called it, is three and a half miles long and sits forty-five fathoms underwater, containing a few shells mixed in with the bones.

In the British seas, the shells and other organic remains lie in soft mud or loose sand and gravel; whereas, in the bed of the Adriatic, Donati found them frequently inclosed in stone of recent origin. This is precisely the difference in character which we might have expected to exist between the British marine formations now in progress and those of the Adriatic; for calcareous and other mineral springs abound in the Mediterranean and lands adjoining, while they are almost entirely wanting in our own country. I have already adverted to the eight regions of different depths in the Ægean Sea, each characterized by a peculiar assemblage of shells, which have been described by Professor E. Forbes, who explored them by dredging. (See above, p. 649.)

In the British seas, shells and other organic remains are found in soft mud or loose sand and gravel; however, in the Adriatic Sea, Donati often found them enclosed in recently formed stone. This is exactly the kind of difference we would expect between the current marine formations in Britain and those in the Adriatic; calcareous and other mineral springs are plentiful in the Mediterranean and nearby lands, while they are nearly absent in our country. I have already mentioned the eight regions of varying depths in the Aegean Sea, each with its own unique collection of shells, as described by Professor E. Forbes, who explored them through dredging. (See above, p. 649.)

During his survey of the west coast of Africa, Captain Sir E. Belcher found, by frequent soundings between the twenty-third and twentieth degrees of north latitude, that the bottom of the sea, at the depth of from twenty to about fifty fathoms, consists of sand with a great intermixture of shells, often entire, but sometimes finely comminuted. Between the eleventh and ninth degrees of north latitude, on the same coast, at soundings varying from twenty to about eighty fathoms, he brought up abundance of corals and shells mixed with sand. These also were in some parts entire, and in others worn and broken.

During his survey of the west coast of Africa, Captain Sir E. Belcher found, through frequent soundings between the twenty-third and twentieth degrees of north latitude, that the sea floor at depths ranging from twenty to about fifty fathoms was made up of sand mixed with a lot of shells, often whole, but sometimes finely crushed. Between the eleventh and ninth degrees of north latitude, along the same coast, at soundings between twenty and about eighty fathoms, he collected a lot of corals and shells mixed with sand. These were also whole in some areas and worn or broken in others.

In all these cases, it is only necessary that there should be some deposition of sedimentary matter, however minute, such as may be supplied by rivers draining a continent, or currents preying on a line of cliffs, in order that stratified formations, hundreds of feet in thickness, and replete with organic remains, should result in the course of ages.

In all these cases, it’s only necessary for there to be some deposit of sediment, no matter how small, like what rivers draining a continent might supply, or currents eroding a line of cliffs, for layered formations, hundreds of feet thick and filled with organic remains, to develop over time.

But although some deposits may thus extend continuously for a thousand miles or more near certain coasts, the greater part of the bed of the ocean, remote from continents and islands, may very probably receive, at the same time, no new accessions of drift matter, all sediment being intercepted by intervening hollows, in which a marine current must clear its waters as thoroughly as a turbid river in a lake. Erroneous theories in geology may be formed not only from overlooking the great extent of simultaneous deposits now in progress, but also from the assumption that such formations may be universal or coextensive with the bed of the ocean.

But even though some deposits can stretch continuously for a thousand miles or more along certain coasts, most of the ocean floor, far from continents and islands, likely isn’t getting any new supplies of drift material at the same time; all the sediment is blocked by intervening depressions, where a marine current must clear its waters as completely as a muddy river does in a lake. Misguided theories in geology can arise not only from failing to recognize the vast extent of simultaneous deposits currently forming but also from assuming that these formations are universal or cover the entire ocean floor.

We frequently observe, on the sea beach, very perfect specimens of fossil shells, quite detached from their matrix, which have been washed out of older formations, constituting the sea-cliffs. They may be all of extinct species, like the Eocene freshwater and marine shells strewed over the shores of Hampshire, yet when they become mingled with the shells of the present period, and buried in the same deposits of mud and sand, they would appear, if upraised and examined by future geologists, to 775 have been all of the same age. That such intermixture and blending of organic remains of different ages have actually taken place in former times, is unquestionable, though the occurrence appears to be very local and exceptional. It is, however, a class of accidents more likely than almost any other to lead to serious anachronisms in geological chronology.

We often see, on the beach, really perfect examples of fossil shells, completely separated from their surrounding material, which have been washed out of older rock formations that make up the sea cliffs. They could all be from extinct species, like the Eocene freshwater and marine shells scattered along the shores of Hampshire. Yet when these shells mix with those from the current era, and are buried in the same layers of mud and sand, they would seem, if lifted and examined by future geologists, to have all come from the same time period. It's undeniable that such mixing and blending of organic remains from different times has actually happened in the past, although it seems to have been quite local and rare. However, this kind of occurrence is more likely than almost any other to cause serious mix-ups in geological timelines.


CHAPTER L.

FORMATION OF CORAL REEFS.

Growth of coral chiefly confined to tropical regions—Principal genera of coral-building zoophytes—Their rate of growth—Seldom flourish at greater depths than twenty fathoms—Atolls or annular reefs with lagoons—Maldive Isles—Origin of the circular form—Coral reefs not based on submerged volcanic craters—Mr. Darwin's theory of subsidence in explanation of atolls, encircling and barrier reefs—Why the windward side of atolls highest—Subsidence explains why all atolls are nearly on one level—Alternate areas of elevation and subsidence—Origin of openings into the lagoons—Size of atolls and barrier reefs—Objection to the theory of subsidence considered—Composition, structure, and stratified arrangement of rocks now forming in coral reefs—Lime, whence derived—Supposed increase of calcareous matter in modern epochs controverted—Concluding remarks.

Growth of coral is mainly found in tropical areas—Main types of coral-building animals—Their growth rate—They usually don’t thrive at depths greater than twenty fathoms—Atolls or ring-shaped reefs with lagoons—Maldive Islands—How the circular shape forms—Coral reefs aren’t based on submerged volcanic craters—Mr. Darwin's subsidence theory explains atolls, encircling, and barrier reefs—Why the windward side of atolls is the highest—Subsidence explains why all atolls are almost at the same level—Alternating areas of rising and sinking—Origin of openings into the lagoons—Size of atolls and barrier reefs—Objections to the subsidence theory discussed—Composition, structure, and layered arrangement of rocks currently forming in coral reefs—Lime, where it comes from—Supposed rise of calcareous material in modern times challenged—Final thoughts.

The powers of the organic creation in modifying the form and structure of the earth's crust, are most conspicuously displayed in the labors of the coral animals. We may compare the operation of these zoophytes in the ocean, to the effects produced on a smaller scale upon the land by the plants which generate peat. In the case of the Sphagnum, the upper part vegetates while the lower part is entering into a mineral mass, in which the traces of organization remain when life has entirely ceased. In corals, in like manner, the more durable materials of the generation that has passed away serve as the foundation on which the living animals continue to rear a similar structure.

The ability of living organisms to change the shape and structure of the earth's surface is most clearly shown in the work of coral animals. We can compare what these tiny sea creatures do in the ocean to the smaller-scale effects of plants that create peat on land. For example, with Sphagnum moss, the upper part grows while the lower part turns into a mineral mass, leaving behind signs of life even after all activity has stopped. Similarly, in corals, the more durable materials from previous generations provide the base on which living animals build a similar structure.

The stony part of the lamelliform zoophyte may be likened to an internal skeleton; for it is always more or less surrounded by a soft animal substance capable of expanding itself; yet, when alarmed, it has the power of contracting and drawing itself almost entirely into the cells and hollows of the hard coral. Although oftentimes beautifully colored in their own element, the soft parts become when taken from the sea nothing more in appearance than a brown slime spread over the stony nucleus.1111

The hard part of the lamelliform zoophyte can be compared to an internal skeleton; it’s usually surrounded by a soft animal tissue that can stretch out, but when threatened, it can pull back almost entirely into the cells and empty spaces of the hard coral. While the soft parts often display beautiful colors in their natural environment, when they’re taken out of the sea, they look like nothing more than a brown slime covering the hard core.1111

The growth of those corals which form reefs of solid stone is entirely confined to the warmer regions of the globe, rarely extending beyond the tropics above two or three degrees, except under peculiar circumstances, 776 as in the Bermuda Islands, in lat. 32° N., where the Atlantic is warmed by the Gulf stream. The Pacific Ocean, throughout a space comprehended between the thirtieth parallels of latitude on each side of the equator, is extremely productive of coral; as also are the Arabian and Persian Gulfs. Coral is also abundant in the sea between the coast of Malabar and the island of Madagascar. Flinders describes a reef of coral on the east coast of New Holland as having a length of nearly 1000 miles, and as being in one part unbroken for a distance of 350 miles. Some groups of coral islands in the Pacific are from 1100 to 1200 miles Fig. 108.Meandrina labyrinthica. Meandrina labyrinthica, Lam. in length, by 300 or 400 in breadth, as the Dangerous Archipelago, for example, and that called Radack by Kotzebue; but the islands within these spaces are always small points, and often very thinly sown.

The growth of corals that form solid stone reefs is mostly limited to warmer areas of the world, rarely moving beyond the tropics by more than two or three degrees, except in special cases, 776 like in the Bermuda Islands at 32° N, where the Gulf Stream warms the Atlantic. The Pacific Ocean, particularly within the thirty-degree latitude bands north and south of the equator, produces a lot of coral, as do the Arabian and Persian Gulfs. Coral is also plentiful in the sea between the Malabar coast and Madagascar. Flinders mentions a coral reef on the east coast of Australia that is nearly 1000 miles long, with one section uninterrupted for about 350 miles. Some clusters of coral islands in the Pacific, such as the Dangerous Archipelago and the one called Radack by Kotzebue, stretch from 1100 to 1200 miles in length and 300 to 400 miles in width, but the islands within these areas are typically tiny and sparsely populated. Fig. 108.Meandrina labyrinthica. Meandrina labyrinthica, Lam.

Of the numerous species of zoophytes which are engaged in the production of coral banks, some of the most common belong to the Lamarckian genera Astrea, Porites, Madrepora, Millepora, Caryophyllia, and Meandrina.

Of the many species of zoophytes involved in creating coral reefs, some of the most common belong to the Lamarckian genera Astrea, Porites, Madrepora, Millepora, Caryophyllia, and Meandrina.

Rate of the growth of Coral.—Very different opinions have been entertained in regard to the rate at which coral reefs increase. In Captain Beechey's late expedition to the Pacific, no positive information could be obtained of any channel having been filled up within a given period; and it seems established, that several reefs had remained for more than half a century, at about the same depth from the surface.

Rate of the growth of Coral.—There are many different opinions about how fast coral reefs grow. During Captain Beechey's recent expedition to the Pacific, no clear evidence was found that any channel had been filled in over a specific time frame; it appears that several reefs have stayed at roughly the same depth from the surface for over fifty years.

Ehrenberg also questions the fact of channels and harbors having been closed up in the Red Sea by the rapid increase of coral limestone. He supposes the notion to have arisen from the circumstance of havens having been occasionally filled up in some places with coral sand, in others with large quantities of ballast of coral rock thrown down from vessels.

Ehrenberg also questions the idea that channels and harbors in the Red Sea were closed off due to the rapid growth of coral limestone. He thinks this notion came about because some havens have occasionally been filled in certain areas with coral sand and in others with large amounts of ballast made of coral rock that was dumped by ships.

Genera of zoophytes commonly found in coral reefs.
Fig. 109.
Astrea dipsacea.

Astrea dipsacea, Lam.

Astrea dipsacea, Lam.

Fig. 110.Extremity of branch of Madrepora muricata, Lin.
Fig. 111.Caryophyllia fastigiata, Lam.

Extremity of branch of Madrepora muricata, Lin.

Extremity of the branch of Madrepora muricata, Lin.

Caryophyllia fastigiata, Lam.

Caryophyllia fastigiata, Lam.

Fig. 112.Porites clavaria, Lam.
Fig. 113.Oculina hirtella, Lam.

Porites clavaria, Lam.

Porites clavaria, Lam.

Oculina hirtella, Lam.

Oculina hirtella, Lam.

The natives of the Bermuda Islands point out certain corals now growing in the sea, which, according to tradition, have been living in the same spots for centuries. It is supposed that some of them may vie in age with the most ancient trees of Europe. Ehrenberg also observed single corals of the genera Meandrina and Favia, having a globular form, from six to nine feet in diameter, "which must (he says) be of immense antiquity, probably several thousand years old, so that Pharaoh may have looked upon these same individuals in the Red Sea."1112 They certainly imply, as he remarks, that the reef on which they grow has increased at a very slow rate. After collecting more than 100 species, he found none of them covered with parasitic zoophytes, nor any instance of a living coral growing on another living coral. To this repulsive power which they exert whilst living, against all others of their own class, we owe the beautiful symmetry of some large Meandrinæ, 778 and other species which adorn our museums. Yet Balani and Serpulæ can attach themselves to living corals, and holes are excavated in them by saxicavous mollusca.

The people of the Bermuda Islands point out certain corals now growing in the sea that, according to tradition, have been in the same places for centuries. It’s believed that some of them might be as old as the most ancient trees in Europe. Ehrenberg also noticed individual corals from the genera Meandrina and Favia, with a round shape, measuring six to nine feet in diameter, “which must (he says) be of immense age, probably several thousand years old, so that Pharaoh may have seen these same individuals in the Red Sea.”1112 They certainly suggest, as he notes, that the reef they grow on has developed at a very slow rate. After collecting over 100 species, he found none of them covered with parasitic zoophytes, nor any instance of a living coral growing on another living coral. To this repulsive power that they exert while alive, against all others of their own kind, we owe the beautiful symmetry of some large Meandrinæ, 778 and other species that decorate our museums. Yet Balani and Serpulæ can attach themselves to living corals, and holes are dug into them by saxicavous mollusca.

At the island called Taaopoto, in the South Pacific, the anchor of a ship, wrecked about 50 years before, was observed in seven fathoms water, still preserving its original form, but entirely incrusted by coral.1113 This fact would seem to imply a slow rate of augmentation; but to form a correct estimate of the average rate must be very difficult, since it must vary not only according to the species of coral, but according to the circumstances under which each species may be placed; such, for example, as the depth from the surface, the quantity of light, the temperature of the water, its freedom from sand or mud, or the absence or presence of breakers, which is favorable to the growth of some kinds and is fatal to that of others. It should also be observed that the apparent stationary condition of some coral reefs, which according to Beechey have remained for centuries at the same depth under water, may be due to subsidence, the upward growth of the coral having been just sufficient to keep pace with the sinking of the solid foundation on which the zoophytes have built. We shall afterwards see how far this hypothesis is borne out by other evidence in the regions of annular reefs or atolls.

At the island called Taaopoto in the South Pacific, the anchor of a ship that sank about 50 years ago was seen in seven fathoms of water, still retaining its original shape but completely covered in coral.1113 This suggests a slow rate of growth; however, accurately estimating the average rate is likely very challenging since it varies not only by the type of coral but also by the conditions each species is in. These conditions include factors like depth from the surface, amount of light, water temperature, and whether the area is free of sand or mud, as well as the presence or absence of waves, which can promote the growth of some types and hinder others. It's also important to note that the seemingly stable position of some coral reefs, which according to Beechey have remained at the same depth for centuries, might be due to sinking land. The coral's upward growth has been just enough to keep pace with the solid foundation sinking underneath it. We will later explore how this theory is supported by further evidence in areas with ring-shaped reefs or atolls.

In one of the Maldive islands a coral reef, which, within a few years, existed on an islet bearing cocoa-nut trees, was found by Lieutenant Prentice, "entirely covered with live coral and madrepore." The natives stated that the islet had been washed away by a change in the currents, and it is clear that a coating of growing coral had been formed in a short time.1114 Experiments, also, of Dr. Allan, on the east coast of Madagascar, prove the possibility of coral growing to a thickness of three feet in about half a year,1115 so that the rate of increase may, under favorable circumstances, be very far from slow.

On one of the Maldives islands, Lieutenant Prentice discovered a coral reef that, within a few years, appeared on a small island with coconut trees, "completely covered with live coral and madrepore." The locals said that the island had been washed away due to a change in the currents, and it's clear that a layer of growing coral formed in a short time.1114 Dr. Allan's experiments on the east coast of Madagascar also show that coral can grow to a thickness of three feet in about six months,1115 indicating that the growth rate can be quite fast under the right conditions.

It must not be supposed that the calcareous masses termed coral reefs are exclusively the work of zoophytes: a great variety of shells, and, among them, some of the largest and heaviest of known species, contribute to augment the mass. In the South Pacific, great beds of oysters, mussels, Pinnæ marinæ, Chamœ (or Tridacnæ), and other shells, cover in profusion almost every reef; and on the beach of coral islands are seen the shells of echini and broken fragments of crustaceous animals. Large shoals of fish are also discernible through the clear blue water, and their teeth and hard palates cannot fail to be often preserved although their soft cartilaginous bones may decay.

It shouldn’t be assumed that the limestone structures known as coral reefs are solely created by zoophytes; a wide range of shells, including some of the largest and heaviest species, also help build up the mass. In the South Pacific, large beds of oysters, mussels, Pinnæ marinæ, Chamœ (or Tridacnæ), and other shells are found abundantly on almost every reef. On the beaches of coral islands, you can see shells of echini and broken pieces of crustaceans. Large schools of fish are also visible in the clear blue water, and their teeth and hard palates are often preserved, even though their soft cartilaginous bones may decay.

It was the opinion of the German naturalist Forster, in 1780, after his voyage round the world with Captain Cook, that coral animals had the power of building up steep and almost perpendicular walls from great depths in the sea, a notion afterwards adopted by Captain Flinders and 779 others; but it is now very generally believed that these zoophytes cannot live in water of great depths.

It was the view of the German naturalist Forster, in 1780, after his journey around the world with Captain Cook, that coral animals could create steep and nearly vertical walls from deep underwater, an idea later accepted by Captain Flinders and 779 others; however, it is now widely believed that these zoophytes cannot survive in very deep water.

Mr. Darwin has come to the conclusion, that those species which are most effective in the construction of reefs, rarely flourish at a greater depth than 20 fathoms, or 120 feet. In some lagoons, however, where the water is but little agitated, there are, according to Kotzebue, beds of living coral in 25 fathoms of water, or 150 feet; but these may perhaps have begun to live in shallower water, and may have been carried downwards by the subsidence of the reef. There are also various species of zoophytes, and among them some which are provided with calcareous as well as horny stems, which live in much deeper water, even in some cases to a depth of 180 fathoms; but these do not appear to give origin to stony reefs.

Mr. Darwin has concluded that the species most responsible for building reefs usually do not thrive at depths greater than 20 fathoms, or 120 feet. However, in some lagoons where the water is relatively calm, there are, according to Kotzebue, living coral beds at 25 fathoms, or 150 feet; but these may have started growing in shallower water and could have been pushed deeper by the sinking of the reef. There are also various types of zoophytes, some with both calcareous and horny stems, that live in much deeper water, even reaching depths of 180 fathoms in some cases; however, these do not seem to form stony reefs.

There is every variety of form in coral reefs, but the most remarkable and numerous in the Pacific consist of circular or oval strips of dry land, enclosing a shallow lake or lagoon of still water, in which zoophytes and mollusca abound. These annular reefs just raise themselves above the level of the sea, and are surrounded by a deep and often unfathomable ocean.

There are all kinds of shapes in coral reefs, but the most impressive and abundant ones in the Pacific are circular or oval strips of dry land that encircle a shallow lake or lagoon filled with calm water, where zoophytes and mollusks thrive. These ring-shaped reefs just rise above sea level and are surrounded by a deep and often immeasurable ocean.

In the annexed cut (fig. 114), one of these circular islands is represented, just rising above the waves, covered with the cocoa-nut and other trees, and inclosing within a lagoon of tranquil water.

In the attached image (fig. 114), one of these circular islands is shown, just above the waves, covered with coconut and other trees, and enclosing a calm lagoon of water.

Fig. 114.View of Whitsunday Island.

View of Whitsunday Island. (Capt. Beechey.)1116

View of Whitsunday Island. (Capt. Beechey.)1116

The accompanying section will enable the reader to comprehend the usual form of such islands. (Fig. 115.)

The following section will help the reader understand the typical shape of these islands. (Fig. 115.)

Fig. 115.Section of a Coral Island.

Section of a Coral Island.

Coral Island section.

a, a, Habitable part of the island, consisting of a strip of coral, inclosing the lagoon.

a, a, The livable area of the island, made up of a coral strip that surrounds the lagoon.

b, b, The lagoon.

b, b, The lagoon.

780 The subjoined cut (fig. 116.) exhibits a small part of the section of a coral island on a larger scale.

780 The image below (fig. 116.) shows a small portion of a coral island section at a larger scale.

Fig. 116.Section of part of a Coral Island.

Section of part of a Coral Island.

Section of part of a Coral Island.

a, b, Habitable part of the island.

a, b, livable area of the island.

b, c, Slope of the side of the island, plunging at an angle of forty-five to the depth of fifteen hundred feet.

b, c, The slope of the island's side drops at a forty-five-degree angle to a depth of fifteen hundred feet.

c, c, Part of the lagoon.

c, c, Section of the lagoon.

d, d, Knolls of coral in the lagoon, with overhanging masses of coral resembling the capitals of columns.

d, d, Mounds of coral in the lagoon, with protruding groups of coral that look like the tops of columns.

Of thirty-two of these coral islands visited by Beechey in his voyage to the Pacific, twenty-nine had lagoons in their centres. The largest was 30 miles in diameter, and the smallest less than a mile. All were increasing their dimensions by the active operations of the lithophytes, which appeared to be gradually extending and bringing the immersed parts of their structure to the surface. The scene presented by these annular reefs is equally striking for its singularity and beauty. A strip of land a few hundred yards wide is covered by lofty cocoa-nut trees, above which is the blue vault of heaven. This band of verdure is bounded by a beach of glittering white sand, the outer margin of which is encircled with a ring of snow-white breakers, beyond which are the dark heaving waters of the ocean. The inner beach incloses the still clear water of the lagoon, resting in its greater part on white sand, and when illuminated by a vertical sun, of a most vivid green.1117 Certain species of zoophytes abound most in the lagoon, others on the exterior margin, where there is a great surf. "The ocean," says Mr. Darwin, "throwing its breakers on these outer shores, appears an invincible enemy, yet we see it resisted and even conquered by means which at first seem most weak and inefficient. No periods of repose are granted, and the long swell caused by the steady action of the trade wind never ceases. The breakers exceed in violence those of our temperate regions, and it is impossible to behold them without feeling a conviction that rocks of granite or quartz would ultimately yield and be demolished by such irresistible forces. Yet these low insignificant coral islets stand and are victorious, for here another power, as antagonist to the former, takes part in the contest. The organic forces separate the atoms of carbonate of lime one by one from the foaming breakers, and unite them into a symmetrical structure; myriads of architects are at work night and day, month after month, and we see their soft and gelatinous bodies through the agency of the vital laws conquering the great mechanical power of the waves of an ocean, which neither the art of man, nor the inanimate works of nature could successfully resist."1118

Of the thirty-two coral islands that Beechey visited during his voyage to the Pacific, twenty-nine had lagoons in their centers. The largest lagoon was 30 miles across, and the smallest was less than a mile. All were growing in size due to the active work of lithophytes, which seemed to be gradually extending and bringing their submerged parts to the surface. The view from these circular reefs is striking for both its uniqueness and beauty. A strip of land a few hundred yards wide is filled with tall coconut trees, under the blue sky above. This green band is bordered by a beach of shining white sand, which is encircled by a ring of bright white waves, beyond which are the dark, rolling waters of the ocean. The inner beach encloses the calm, clear water of the lagoon, mostly resting on white sand, which shines a vivid green under the direct sunlight. Certain types of zoophytes thrive in the lagoon, while others are found on the outer edge where the surf is strong. "The ocean," says Mr. Darwin, "crashing its waves against these outer shores seems like an unbeatable enemy, yet we see it resisted and even overcome by means that initially appear weak and ineffective. There are no moments of calm, and the long swells caused by the constant trade winds never stop. The waves are more violent than those in our temperate regions, and it’s impossible to watch them without being convinced that rocks of granite or quartz would eventually give in and be destroyed by such overwhelming forces. Yet these low, small coral islets remain intact and victorious, as another force, opposing the first, joins the struggle. The organic forces extract the atoms of calcium carbonate one by one from the crashing waves and assemble them into a neat structure; countless architects work tirelessly day and night, month after month, and we see their soft, gelatinous bodies, through the laws of life, conquering the immense mechanical power of the ocean's waves, which neither human skill nor the unyielding works of nature could resist."

781 As the coral animals require to be continually immersed in salt water, they cannot raise themselves by their own efforts, above the level of the lowest tides. The manner in which the reefs are converted into islands above the level of the sea is thus described by Chamisso, a naturalist, who accompanied Kotzebue in his voyages:—"When the reef," says he, "is of such a height that it remains almost dry at low water the corals leave off building. Above this line a continuous mass of solid stone is seen composed of the shells of mollusks and echini, with their broken-off prickles and fragments of coral, united by calcareous sand, produced by the pulverization of shells. The heat of the sun often penetrates the mass of stone when it is dry, so that it splits in many places, and the force of the waves is thereby enabled to separate and lift blocks of coral, frequently six feet long and three or four in thickness, and throw them upon the reef, by which means the ridge becomes at length so high that it is covered only during some seasons of the year by the spring tides. After this the calcareous sand lies undisturbed, and offers to the seeds of trees and plants cast upon it by the waves a soil upon which they rapidly grow, to overshadow its dazzling white surface. Entire trunks of trees, which are carried by the rivers from other countries and islands, find here, at length, a resting-place after their long wanderings: with these come some small animals such as insects and lizards, as the first inhabitants. Even before the trees form a wood, the sea-birds nestle here; stray land-birds take refuge in the bushes; and, at a much later period, when the work has been long since completed, man appears and builds his hut on the fruitful soil."1119

781 Since coral animals need to stay submerged in saltwater, they can't lift themselves above the level of the lowest tides. Chamisso, a naturalist who traveled with Kotzebue, describes how reefs become islands above sea level: "When the reef reaches a height that it stays almost dry at low tide, the corals stop building. Above this point, you can see a solid mass of stone made up of mollusk shells and sea urchins, along with their broken spines and pieces of coral, all combined with calcareous sand formed from crushed shells. The sun's heat often cracks this stone mass when it's dry, allowing the waves to break off and lift chunks of coral, sometimes six feet long and three or four feet thick, and toss them onto the reef. This way, the ridge eventually becomes so high that it’s only covered by spring tides during certain times of the year. Afterward, the calcareous sand remains undisturbed, providing a fertile ground for tree and plant seeds dropped by the waves, enabling them to grow quickly and cover its bright white surface. Whole tree trunks, carried here by rivers from other places, finally rest after their long journey, bringing small animals like insects and lizards as the first inhabitants. Even before the trees form a forest, sea birds nest here; stray land birds find shelter in the bushes; and much later, once this process is complete, humans arrive to build their huts on this rich soil."1119

In the above description the solid stone is stated to consist of shell and coral, united by sand; but masses of very compact limestone are also found even in the uppermost and newest parts of the reef, such as could only have been produced by chemical precipitation. Professor Agassiz also informs me that his observations on the Florida reefs (which confirm Darwin's theory of atolls to be mentioned in the sequel) have convinced him, that large blocks are loosened, not by shrinkage in the sun's heat, as Chamisso imagined, but by innumerable perforations of lithodomi and other boring testacea.

In the description above, it mentions that the solid stone is made up of shell and coral, held together by sand. However, there are also very dense limestone masses found even in the highest and most recent parts of the reef, which could only be formed through chemical precipitation. Professor Agassiz also tells me that his observations of the Florida reefs (which support Darwin's theory of atolls that will be discussed later) have convinced him that large blocks are loosened not by the sun's heat causing them to shrink, as Chamisso thought, but by countless holes made by lithodomi and other boring shellfish.

The carbonate of lime may have been principally derived from the decomposition of corals and testacea; for when the animal matter undergoes putrefaction, the calcareous residuum must be set free under circumstances very favorable to precipitation, especially when there are other calcareous substances, such as shells and corals, on which it may be deposited. Thus organic bodies may be inclosed in a solid cement, and become portions of rocky masses.1120

The lime carbonate likely mainly comes from the breakdown of corals and shellfish; when the organic matter decays, the calcium remains can be released in conditions that are very conducive to precipitation, especially when there are other calcium-rich materials like shells and corals where it can settle. This way, organic materials can be trapped in solid cement and turn into parts of rock formations.1120

The width of the circular strip of dead coral forming the islands explored by Captain Beechey, exceeded in no instance half a mile from the usual wash of the sea to the edge of the lagoon, and, in general, was only about three or four hundred yards.1121 The depth of the lagoons is 782 various; in some, entered by Captain Beechey, it was from twenty to thirty-eight fathoms.

The width of the circular strip of dead coral creating the islands explored by Captain Beechey never exceeded half a mile from the usual sea wash to the edge of the lagoon, and generally was only about three or four hundred yards.1121 The depth of the lagoons varies; in some that Captain Beechey entered, it ranged from twenty to thirty-eight fathoms.

The two other peculiarities which are most characteristic of the annular Fig. 117.Section of part of a Coral Island. Section of part of a Coral Island. reef or atoll are first, that the strip of dead coral is invariably highest on the windward side, and secondly, that there is very generally an opening at some point in the reef affording a narrow passage, often of considerable depth, from the sea into the lagoon.

The two other features that are most typical of the annular Fig. 117.Section of a Coral Island. Section of a Coral Island. reef or atoll are, first, that the strip of dead coral is always highest on the windward side, and second, that there is usually an opening at some point in the reef, providing a narrow passage, often quite deep, from the sea into the lagoon.

Maldive and Laccadive Isles.—The chain of reefs and islets called the Maldives (see fig. 117.), situated in the Indian Ocean, to the south-west of Malabar, forms a chain 470 geographical miles in length, running due north and south, with an average breadth of about 50 miles. It is composed throughout of a series of circular assemblages of islets, all formed of coral, the larger groups being from forty to ninety miles in their longest diameter. Captain Horsburgh, whose chart of these islands is subjoined, states, that outside of each circle or atoll, as it is termed, there are coral reefs sometimes extending to the distance of two or three miles, beyond which there are no soundings at immense depths. But in the centre of each atoll there is a lagoon from fifteen to forty-nine fathoms deep. In the channels between the atolls no soundings can usually be obtained at the depth of 150 or even 250 fathoms, but during Captain Moresby's survey, soundings were struck at 150 and 200 fathoms, the only instances as yet known of the bottom having been reached, either in the Indian or Pacific oceans, in a space intervening between two separate and well characterized atolls.

Maldive and Laccadive Isles.—The chain of reefs and islets known as the Maldives (see fig. 117.) is located in the Indian Ocean, southwest of Malabar. It stretches 470 geographical miles in length, running directly north and south, with an average width of about 50 miles. It's made up of a series of circular groups of islets, all formed from coral, with the larger clusters measuring between forty and ninety miles in their longest dimension. Captain Horsburgh, whose chart of these islands is included, indicates that outside each circle, or atoll, as it's called, there are coral reefs that sometimes extend two to three miles out, beyond which the depths are immeasurable. However, in the center of each atoll, there’s a lagoon ranging from fifteen to forty-nine fathoms deep. In the channels between the atolls, it's usually impossible to obtain soundings at depths of 150 or even 250 fathoms. Yet, during Captain Moresby's survey, soundings were measured at 150 and 200 fathoms, marking the only known instances of reaching the seabed in the Indian or Pacific oceans in the space between two distinct and well-defined atolls.

The singularity in the form of the atolls of this archipelago consists in their being made up, not of one continuous circular reef but of a ring of small coral islets sometimes more than a hundred in number, each of which is a miniature atoll in itself; in other words, a ring-shaped strip of coral surrounding a lagoon of salt water. To account for the origin of these, Mr. Darwin supposes the larger annular reef to have been broken up into a number of fragments, each of which acquired its peculiar configurations under the influence of causes similar to those to which the 783 structure of the parent atoll has been due. Many of the minor rings are no less than three, and even five miles in diameter, and some are situated in the midst of the principal lagoon; but this happens only in cases where the sea can enter freely through breaches in the outer or marginal reef.

The uniqueness of the atolls in this archipelago lies in their composition; they are not formed from one continuous circular reef but rather from a ring of small coral islets, sometimes numbering over a hundred, each functioning as a miniature atoll. In other words, these are ring-shaped strips of coral that encircle a lagoon of saltwater. To explain their origin, Mr. Darwin suggests that the larger annular reef broke into many pieces, each developing its own distinct shapes due to influences similar to those that created the structure of the original atoll. Many of the smaller rings are anywhere from three to five miles in diameter, and some are located in the center of the main lagoon; however, this occurs only when the sea can flow freely through gaps in the outer or edge reef.

The rocks of the Maldives are composed of sandstone formed of broken shells and corals, such as may be obtained in a loose state from the beach, and which is seen when exposed for a few days to the air to become hardened. The sandstone is sometimes observed to be an aggregate of broken shells, corals, pieces of wood, and shells of the cocoa-nut.1122

The rocks of the Maldives are made up of sandstone, which consists of broken shells and corals that can be found loose on the beach. When exposed to the air for a few days, this material hardens. The sandstone sometimes appears as a mix of broken shells, corals, bits of wood, and coconut shells.1122

The Laccadive islands run in the same line with the Maldives, on the north, as do the isles of the Chagos Archipelago, on the south; so that these may be continuations of the same chain of submerged mountains, crested in a similar manner by coral limestones.

The Laccadive Islands are aligned with the Maldives to the north, just as the islands of the Chagos Archipelago are to the south. This suggests that they might be parts of the same chain of underwater mountains, topped in a similar way by coral limestone.

Origin of the circular form—not volcanic.—The circular and oval shape of so many reefs, each having a lagoon in the centre, and being surrounded on all sides by a deep ocean, naturally suggested the idea that they were nothing more than the crests of submarine volcanic craters overgrown by coral; and this theory I myself advocated in the earlier editions of this work. Although I am now about to show that it must be abandoned, it may still be instructive to point out the grounds on which it was formerly embraced. In the first place, it had been remarked that there were many active volcanoes in the coral region of the Pacific, and that in some places, as in Gambier's group, rocks composed of porous lava rise up in a lagoon bordered by a circular reef, just as the two cones of eruption called the Kamenis have made their appearance in the times of history within the circular gulf of Santorin.1123 It was also observed that, as in S. Shetland, Barren Island, and others of volcanic origin, there is one narrow breach in the walls of the outer cone by which ships may enter a circular gulf, so in like manner there is often a single deep passage leading into the lagoon of a coral island, the lagoon itself seeming to represent the hollow or gulf just as the ring of dry coral recalls to our minds the rim of a volcanic crater. More lately, indeed, Mr. Darwin has shown that the numerous volcanic craters of the Galapagos Archipelago in the Pacific have all of them their southern sides the lowest, or in many cases quite broken down, so that if they were submerged and incrusted with coral, they would resemble true atolls in shape.1124

Origin of the circular form—not volcanic.—The circular and oval shapes of many reefs, each with a lagoon in the center and surrounded on all sides by a deep ocean, naturally led to the idea that they were simply the tops of underwater volcanic craters covered with coral; this theory was something I supported in the earlier editions of this work. Although I'm about to explain why it needs to be discarded, it can still be helpful to highlight the reasons it was previously accepted. First, it was noted that there are many active volcanoes in the coral region of the Pacific, and in some areas, like Gambier's group, rocks made of porous lava rise in a lagoon bordered by a circular reef, much like the two eruption cones known as the Kamenis that appeared in historical times within the circular gulf of Santorin.1123 It was also observed that, similar to S. Shetland, Barren Island, and other volcanic places, there is often a narrow gap in the walls of the outer cone where ships can enter a circular gulf; likewise, there is often a single deep passage leading into the lagoon of a coral island, with the lagoon itself appearing to represent the hollow or gulf, just as the dry coral ring reminds us of the rim of a volcanic crater. Recently, Mr. Darwin has pointed out that the numerous volcanic craters of the Galapagos Archipelago in the Pacific all have their southern sides lower, or in many cases completely eroded, so that if they were submerged and covered with coral, they would look like true atolls in shape.1124

Another argument which I adduced when formerly defending this doctrine was derived from Ehrenberg's statement, that some banks of coral in the Red Sea were square, while many others were ribbon-like strips, with flat tops, and without lagoons. Since, therefore, all the genera and many of the species of zoophytes in the Red Sea agreed with those which elsewhere construct lagoon islands, it followed that the stone-making 784 zoophytes are not guided by their own instinct in the formation of annular reefs, but that this peculiar shape and the position of such reefs in the midst of a deep ocean must depend on the outline of the submarine bottom, which resembles nothing else in nature but the crater of a lofty submerged volcanic cone. The enormous size, it is true, of some atolls, made it necessary for me to ascribe to the craters of many submarine volcanoes a magnitude which was startling, and which had often been appealed to as a serious objection to the volcanic theory. That so many of them were of the same height, or just level with the water, did not present a difficulty so long as we remained ignorant of the fact that the reef-building species do not grow at greater depths than twenty-five fathoms.

Another argument I presented when previously defending this theory came from Ehrenberg's observation that some coral banks in the Red Sea were square, while many others were long ribbon-like strips with flat tops and no lagoons. Since all the genera and many species of zoophytes in the Red Sea matched those that elsewhere build lagoon islands, it followed that the organisms creating these reefs aren't driven by their instinct to form circular reefs. Instead, this unique shape and the location of such reefs in the middle of a deep ocean must depend on the shape of the underwater landscape, which resembles nothing else in nature except the crater of a tall submerged volcanic cone. The immense size of certain atolls did require me to attribute a size to many underwater volcano craters that was surprising, and this has often been used as a serious argument against the volcanic theory. The fact that so many of them were the same height or just above water was not an issue as long as we were unaware that the species responsible for building reefs do not grow at depths greater than twenty-five fathoms.

May be explained by subsidence.—Mr. Darwin, after examining a variety of coral formations in different parts of the globe, was induced to reject the opinion that their shape represented the form of the original bottom. Instead of admitting that the ring of dead coral rested on a circular or oval ridge of rock, or that the lagoon corresponded to a preexisting cavity, he advanced a new opinion, which must, at first sight, seem paradoxical in the extreme; namely, that the lagoon is precisely in the place once occupied by the highest part of a mountainous island, or, in other cases, by the top of a shoal.

May be explained by subsidence.—Mr. Darwin, after studying various coral formations around the world, decided to dismiss the view that their shape mirrored the original seafloor. Instead of accepting that the ring of dead coral rested on a circular or oval ridge of rock, or that the lagoon matched an existing cavity, he proposed a new idea that might initially appear quite contradictive; specifically, that the lagoon is exactly where the highest point of a mountainous island used to be, or, in other cases, where the top of a shoal was located.

The following is a brief sketch of the facts and arguments in favor of this new view:—Besides those rings of dry coral which enclose lagoons, there are others having a similar form and structure which encircle lofty islands. Of the latter kind is Vanikoro, (see map, fig. 39, p. 351,) celebrated on account of the shipwreck of La Peyrouse, where the coral reef runs at the distance of two or three miles from the shore, the channel between it and the land having a general depth of between 200 and 300 feet. This channel, therefore, is analogous to a lagoon, but with an island standing in the middle like a picture in its frame. In like manner in Tahiti we see a mountainous land, with everywhere round its margin a lake or zone of smooth salt water, separated from the ocean by an encircling reef of coral, on which a line of breakers is always foaming. So also New Caledonia, a long narrow island east of New Holland, in which the rocks are granitic, is surrounded by a reef which runs for a length of 400 miles. This reef encompasses not only the island itself, but a ridge of rocks which are prolonged in the same direction beneath the sea. No one, therefore, will contend for a moment that in this case the corals are based upon the rim of a volcanic crater, in the middle of which stands a mountain or island of granite.

The following is a brief overview of the facts and arguments supporting this new perspective:—In addition to the dry coral rings that enclose lagoons, there are others with a similar shape and structure that circle tall islands. One such island is Vanikoro, (see map, fig. 39, p. 351,) famous for the shipwreck of La Peyrouse, where the coral reef is located two or three miles from the shore, and the channel between it and the land generally has a depth of 200 to 300 feet. This channel is therefore similar to a lagoon, but with an island in the middle like a picture in a frame. Similarly, in Tahiti, we see mountainous land surrounded by a lake or area of calm saltwater, separated from the ocean by a coral reef that constantly has waves breaking on it. New Caledonia, a long narrow island east of New Holland with granitic rocks, is also surrounded by a reef that extends for 400 miles. This reef encircles not just the island itself but also a ridge of rocks that continues in the same direction beneath the sea. Thus, no one would argue for a moment that in this case the corals sit on the rim of a volcanic crater, with a granite mountain or island in the center.

The great barrier reef, already mentioned as running parallel to the north-east coast of Australia for nearly 1000 miles, is another most remarkable example of a long strip of coral running parallel to a coast. Its distance from the mainland varies from twenty to seventy miles, and the depth of the great arm of the sea thus enclosed is usually between ten and twenty fathoms, but towards one end from forty to sixty. This great reef would extend much farther, according to Mr. Jukes, if the growth of 785 coral were not prevented off the shores of New Guinea by a muddy bottom, caused by rivers charged with sediment which flow from the southern coast of that great island.1125

The Great Barrier Reef, previously noted as stretching along the northeast coast of Australia for nearly 1,000 miles, is another remarkable example of a long chain of coral parallel to a coastline. Its distance from the mainland ranges from twenty to seventy miles, and the depth of the large body of water it encloses is typically between ten and twenty fathoms, although at one end it reaches depths of forty to sixty fathoms. According to Mr. Jukes, this massive reef would extend even farther if coral growth weren’t held back off the shores of New Guinea due to a muddy seabed created by sediment-laden rivers flowing from the southern coast of that large island.7851125

Two classes of reefs, therefore, have now been considered; first, the atoll, and, secondly, the encircling and barrier reef, all agreeing perfectly in structure, and the sole difference lying in the absence in the case of the atoll of all land, and in the others the presence of land bounded either by an encircling or a barrier reef. But there is still a third class of reefs, called by Mr. Darwin "fringing reefs," which approach much nearer the land than those of the encircling and barrier class, and which indeed so nearly touched the coast as to leave nothing in the intervening space resembling a lagoon. "That these reefs are not attached quite close to the shore appears to be the result of two causes; first, that the water immediately adjoining the beach is rendered turbid by the surf, and therefore injurious to all zoophytes; and, secondly, that the larger and efficient kinds only flourish on the outer edge amidst the breakers of the open sea."1126

Two types of reefs have now been discussed: first, the atoll, and second, the encircling and barrier reef, which all have the same structure. The only difference is that the atoll has no land, while the others have land either surrounded by an encircling reef or separated by a barrier reef. However, there is a third type of reef, referred to by Mr. Darwin as "fringing reefs," which are much closer to the land compared to the encircling and barrier reefs. They come so close to the coast that there is no lagoon-like space between them and the shore. The reason these reefs aren’t attached directly to the beach seems to be due to two factors: first, the water next to the beach is made murky by the waves, which is harmful to all types of marine life; and second, the larger and stronger species thrive only on the outer edge among the waves of the open sea.1126

Fig. 118.Supposed section of an island with an encircling reef of coral.

Supposed section of an island with an encircling reef of coral.

Supposed part of an island surrounded by a coral reef.

A, The island.

The island.

b, c, Highest points of the encircling reef between which and the coast is seen a space occupied by still water.

b, c, The highest points of the surrounding reef between which and the shore is a calm area of still water.

It will at once be conceded that there is so much analogy between the form and position of the strip of coral in the atoll, and in the encircling and barrier reef, that no explanation can be satisfactory which does not include the whole. If we turn in the first place to the encircling and barrier reefs, and endeavor to explain how the zoophytes could have found a bottom on which to begin to build, we are met at once with a great difficulty. It is a general fact, long since remarked by Dampier, that high land and deep seas go together. In other words, steep mountains coming down abruptly to the sea-shore are generally continued with the same slope beneath the water. But where the reef, as at b and c (fig. 118), is distant several miles from a steep coast, a line drawn perpendicularly downwards from its outer edges b c to the fundamental rock d e, must descend to a depth exceeding by several thousand feet the limits at which the efficient stone-building corals can exist, for we have seen that they cease to grow in water which is more than 120 feet deep. That the original root immediately beneath the points b c is actually as far from the surface as d e, is not merely inferred from Dampier's rule, 786 but confirmed by the fact, that, immediately outside the reef, soundings are either not met with at all, or only at enormous depths. In short, the ocean is as deep there as might have been anticipated in the neighborhood of a bold coast; and it is obviously the presence of the coral alone which has given rise to the anomalous existence of shallow water on the reef and between it and the land.

It's clear that there's a strong similarity between the shape and location of the coral strip in the atoll and the surrounding barrier reef, so any explanation that doesn't cover the entire picture won't be satisfying. If we first look at the surrounding and barrier reefs and try to understand how the coral organisms were able to find a base to start building, we immediately encounter a major challenge. It's a well-known fact, noted by Dampier, that high land is typically found alongside deep seas. In other words, steep mountains that drop sharply to the coastline usually continue at the same angle beneath the water. However, where the reef, like at b and c (fig. 118), is several miles away from a steep coast, a line drawn straight down from its outer edges b c to the underlying rock d e must go down to a depth that is several thousand feet deeper than the layer where the key coral-building species can survive. We know they stop growing in water deeper than 120 feet. The fact that the original base right below the points b c is actually as far from the surface as d e isn't just a guess based on Dampier's observation, but is supported by the evidence that, just outside the reef, the depths either aren’t measured at all or are measured at extremely deep levels. In short, the ocean there is as deep as you'd expect near a steep coast; and it's clear that the coral's presence is what has created the unusual condition of shallow water on the reef and between it and the land.

After studying in minute detail all the phenomena above described, Mr. Darwin has offered in explanation a theory now very generally adopted. The coral-forming polypi, he states, begin to build in water of a moderate depth, and while they are yet at work, the bottom of the sea subsides gradually, so that the foundation of their edifice is carried downwards at the same time that they are raising the superstructure. If, therefore, the rate of subsidence be not too rapid, the growing coral will continue to build up to the surface; the mass always gaining in height above its original base, but remaining in other respects in the same position. Not so with the land; each inch lost is irreclaimably gone; as it sinks, the water gains foot by foot on the shore, till in many cases the highest peak of the original island disappears. What was before land is then occupied by the lagoon, the position of the encircling coral remaining unaltered, with the exception of a slight contraction of its dimensions.

After carefully examining all the phenomena mentioned above, Mr. Darwin has proposed a theory that is now widely accepted. He explains that the coral-forming polyps start to build in water that's at a moderate depth, and while they are working, the ocean floor gradually sinks. This means the base of their structure is moving downward at the same time they're raising the upper part. If the rate of sinking isn't too fast, the growing coral will keep building up to the surface, gaining height above its original base while remaining otherwise in the same position. This is different for land; every inch that is lost is permanently gone. As it sinks, the water advances closer to the shore, until often the highest point of the original island disappears. What was once land is then taken over by the lagoon, while the position of the surrounding coral stays basically the same, except for a slight reduction in size.

In this manner are encircling reefs and atolls produced; and in confirmation of his views Mr. Darwin has pointed out examples which illustrate every intermediate state, from that of lofty islands, such as Otaheite, encircled by coral, to that of Gambier's group, where a few peaks only of land rise out of a lagoon, and lastly, to the perfect atoll, having a lagoon several hundred feet deep, surrounded by a reef rising steeply from an unfathomed ocean.

In this way, encircling reefs and atolls are formed. To support his ideas, Mr. Darwin has highlighted examples that show every intermediate stage, from high islands like Tahiti, surrounded by coral, to Gambier's group, where only a few peaks of land emerge from a lagoon, and finally to the perfect atoll, which has a lagoon several hundred feet deep, surrounded by a reef that rises sharply from the deep ocean.

Fig. 119.Regions of growing coral.

If we embrace these views, it is clear, that in regions of growing coral a similar subsidence must give rise to barrier reefs along the shores of a continent. Thus suppose A (fig. 119), to represent the north-east portion of Australia, and b c the ancient level of the sea, when the coral reef d was formed. If the land sink so that it is submerged more and more, the sea must at length stand at the level e f, the reef in the mean time having been enlarged and raised to the point g. The distance between the shore f, and the barrier reef g, is now much greater than originally between the shore c and the reef d, and the longer the subsidence continues the farther will the coast of the mainland recede.

If we accept these ideas, it’s clear that in areas where coral is thriving, a similar sinking must create barrier reefs along the edges of a continent. Let's consider A (fig. 119) to represent the northeastern part of Australia, and b c as the ancient sea level when the coral reef d was formed. If the land continues to sink and becomes increasingly submerged, the sea will eventually rise to the level e f, while in the meantime, the reef has expanded and been elevated to point g. The distance between the shore f and the barrier reef g is now much greater than the original distance between the shore c and the reef d, and the longer the sinking persists, the further the coastline of the mainland will retreat.

When the first edition of this work appeared in 1831, several years before Mr. Darwin had investigated the facts on which his theory is 787 founded, I had come to the opinion that the land was subsiding at the bottom of those parts of the Pacific where atolls are numerous, although I failed to perceive that such a subsidence, if conceded, would equally solve the enigma as to the form both of annular and barrier reefs.

When the first edition of this work came out in 1831, several years before Mr. Darwin explored the facts that support his theory, I had already concluded that the land was sinking in the areas of the Pacific where atolls are plentiful. However, I didn’t realize that this sinking, if accepted, would also explain the shape of both ring-shaped and barrier reefs.

I shall cite the passage referred to, as published by me in 1831:—"It is a remarkable circumstance that there should be so vast an area in Eastern Oceanica, studded with minute islands, without one single spot where there is a wider extent of land than belongs to such islands as Otaheite, Owhyhee, and a few others, which either have been or are still the seats of active volcanoes. If an equilibrium only were maintained between the upheaving and depressing force of earthquakes, large islands would very soon be formed in the Pacific; for, in that case, the growth of limestone, the flowing of lava, and the ejection of volcanic ashes, would combine with the upheaving force to form new land.

I’ll quote the passage I published in 1831:—"It’s surprising that there’s such a vast area in Eastern Oceanica filled with tiny islands, yet not a single spot with more land than islands like Tahiti, Hawaii, and a few others that have either been or still are active volcano sites. If there were just a balance between the forces that push up and pull down from earthquakes, large islands would quickly form in the Pacific; because in that case, the growth of limestone, flowing lava, and volcanic ash would work together with the uplift force to create new land."

"Suppose a shoal, 600 miles in length, to sink fifteen feet, and then to remain unmoved for a thousand years; during that interval the growing coral may again approach the surface. Then let the mass be re-elevated fifteen feet, so that the original reef is restored to its former position: in this case, the new coral formed since the first subsidence will constitute an island 600 miles long. An analogous result would have occurred if a lava-current fifteen feet thick had overflowed the submerged reef. The absence, therefore, of more extensive tracts of land in the Pacific, seems to show that the amount of subsidence by earthquakes exceeds, in that quarter of the globe, at present, the elevation due to the same cause."1127

"Imagine a reef that’s 600 miles long sinking fifteen feet and then staying unchanged for a thousand years; during that time, new coral might grow back up to the surface. Now, if that reef were raised back up fifteen feet, bringing it back to its original height, the new coral that formed since the first sinking would create an island that is 600 miles long. A similar outcome would occur if a lava flow that was fifteen feet thick had covered the submerged reef. Therefore, the lack of larger land areas in the Pacific suggests that currently, in that part of the world, the amount of sinking caused by earthquakes is greater than the elevation caused by the same thing." 1127

Another proof also of subsidence derived from the structure of atolls, was pointed out by me in the following passage in all former editions. "The low coral islands of the Pacific," says Captain Beechey, "follow one general rule in having their windward side higher and more perfect than the other. At Gambia and Matilda islands this inequality is very conspicuous, the weather side of both being wooded, and of the former inhabited, while the other sides are from twenty to thirty feet under water; where, however, they may be perceived to be equally narrow and well defined. It is on the leeward side also that the entrances into the lagoons occur; and although they may sometimes be situated on a side that runs in the direction of the wind, as at Bow Island, yet there are none to windward." These observations of Captain Beechey accord with those which Captain Horsburgh and other hydrographers have made in regard to the coral islands of other seas. From this fortunate circumstance ships can enter and sail out with ease; whereas if the narrow inlets were to windward, vessels which once entered might not succeed for months in making their way out again. The well-known security of many of these harbors depends entirely on this fortunate peculiarity in their structure.

Another proof of subsidence can be seen in the structure of atolls, which I previously highlighted in all earlier editions. "The low coral islands of the Pacific," says Captain Beechey, "generally have their windward side higher and more intact than the other side. At Gambia and Matilda islands, this difference is very noticeable, with the weather side of both being forested and the former inhabited, while the other sides are submerged about twenty to thirty feet; however, they still appear to be equally narrow and well-defined. The entrances to the lagoons are also found on the leeward side; and while they may sometimes be located on a side facing the wind, like at Bow Island, there are none to windward." Captain Beechey's observations align with those of Captain Horsburgh and other hydrographers regarding the coral islands in other seas. This fortunate feature allows ships to enter and exit with ease; if the narrow inlets were to windward, vessels that entered might struggle for months to get back out. The well-known safety of many of these harbors relies completely on this lucky aspect of their design.

"In what manner is this singular conformation to be accounted for? The action of the waves is seen to be the cause of the superior elevation 788 of some reefs on their windward sides, where sand and large masses of coral rock are thrown up by the breakers; but there is a variety of cases where this cause alone is inadequate to solve the problem; for reefs submerged at considerable depths, where the movements of the sea cannot exert much power, have, nevertheless, the same conformation, the leeward being much lower than the windward side.1128

"In what way can we explain this unique shape? The waves are clearly responsible for the increased height of some reefs on their windward sides, where sand and large pieces of coral are pushed up by the crashing surf. However, there are various situations where this explanation falls short; reefs that are submerged at significant depths, where the ocean's movement can't have much impact, still maintain the same structure, with the leeward side being much lower than the windward side.1128

"I am informed by Captain King, that, on examining the reefs called Rowley Shoals, which lie off the north-west coast of Australia, where the east and west monsoons prevail alternately, he found the open side of one crescent-shaped reef, the Impérieuse, turned to the east, and of another, the Mermaid, turned to the west; while a third oval reef, of the same group, was entirely submerged. This want of conformity is exactly what we should expect, where the winds vary periodically.

"I was told by Captain King that, when he was checking out the reefs called Rowley Shoals, which are located off the northwest coast of Australia and where the east and west monsoons alternate, he found that the open side of one crescent-shaped reef, the Impérieuse, faced east, while another, the Mermaid, faced west; and a third oval reef in the same group was completely underwater. This lack of consistency is exactly what we would expect in an area where the winds change periodically."

"It seems impossible to refer the phenomenon now under consideration to any original uniformity in the configuration of submarine volcanoes, on the summits of which we may suppose the coral reefs to grow; for although it is very common for craters to be broken down on one side only, we cannot imagine any cause that should breach them all in the same direction. But the difficulty will, perhaps, be removed, if we call in another part of the volcanic agency—subsidence by earthquakes. Suppose the windward barrier to have been raised by the mechanical action of the waves to the height of two or three yards above the wall on the leeward side, and then the whole island to sink down a few fathoms, the appearances described would then be presented by the submerged reef. A repetition of such operations, by the alternate elevation and depression of the same mass (an hypothesis strictly conformable to analogy), might produce still greater inequality in the two sides, especially as the violent efflux of the tide has probably a strong tendency to check the accumulation of the more tender corals on the leeward reef; while the action of the breakers contributes to raise the windward barrier."1129

"It seems impossible to tie the current phenomenon to any original consistency in the shape of underwater volcanoes, where we can assume the coral reefs grow. Although it's common for craters to have a breakdown on only one side, we can’t envision any reason that would cause all of them to collapse in the same direction. However, this issue might be resolved if we consider another factor of volcanic activity—subsidence due to earthquakes. Imagine the windward barrier being raised by the mechanical action of the waves to a height of two or three yards above the wall on the leeward side, and then the entire island sinking down a few fathoms; the submerged reef would then show the described characteristics. Repeating such processes, with the same land mass alternately moving up and down (a scenario that aligns with previous observations), could lead to even greater imbalance between the two sides. This is especially true since the strong outflow of the tide likely hinders the growth of more delicate corals on the leeward reef, while the action of the waves helps to raise the windward barrier." 1129

Previously to my adverting to the signs above enumerated of a downward movement in the bed of the ocean, Dr. MacCulloch, Captain Beechey, and many other writers, had shown that masses of recent coral had been laid dry at various heights above the sea-level, both in the Red Sea, the islands of the Pacific, and in the East and West Indies. After describing thirty-two coral islands in the Pacific, Captain Beechey mentioned that they were all formed of living coral except one, which, although of coral formation, was raised about seventy or eighty feet above the level of the sea, and was encompassed by a reef of living coral. It is called Elizabeth or Henderson's Island, and is five miles in length by one in breadth. It has a flat surface, and, on all sides, except the north, is bounded by perpendicular cliffs about fifty feet high, composed entirely of dead coral, more or less porous, honey-combed at the surface, and hardening 789 into a compact calcareous mass, which possesses the fracture of secondary limestone, and has a species of millepore interspersed through it. These cliffs are considerably undermined by the action of the waves, and some of them appear on the eve of precipitating their superincumbent weight into the sea. Those which are less injured in this way present no alternate ridges or indication of the different levels which the sea might have occupied at different periods; but a smooth surface, as if the island, which has probably been raised by volcanic agency, had been forced up by one great subterraneous convulsion.1130 At the distance of a few hundred yards from this island, no bottom could be gained with 200 fathoms of line.

Before I mentioned the signs of a downward shift in the ocean floor, Dr. MacCulloch, Captain Beechey, and several other writers had shown that large areas of recent coral had been exposed at various heights above sea level, in the Red Sea, the Pacific islands, and in the East and West Indies. After detailing thirty-two coral islands in the Pacific, Captain Beechey noted that all of them were made of living coral except one. This particular island, although coral-based, was elevated about seventy to eighty feet above sea level and was surrounded by a reef of living coral. It is called Elizabeth or Henderson's Island, measuring five miles long and one mile wide. The island has a flat surface, and except for the north side, it is bordered by vertical cliffs about fifty feet high, made entirely of dead coral that is more or less porous, pockmarked at the surface, and hardening into a solid calcareous mass that breaks like secondary limestone, with a type of millepore scattered throughout. These cliffs have been significantly eroded by wave action, and some seem poised to collapse into the sea. Those cliffs that are less damaged do not show alternating ridges or signs of the different tidal levels the sea might have reached at various times but instead have a smooth surface, as if the island—most likely raised by volcanic activity—was lifted in one massive underground upheaval.789 A few hundred yards from this island, no bottom could be found with 200 fathoms of line.

Fig. 120.Elizabeth, or Henderson's Island.

Elizabeth, or Henderson's Island.

Elizabeth or Henderson Island.

It will be seen, from the annexed sketch, communicated to me by Lieutenant Smith, of the Blossom, that the trees came down to the beach towards the centre of the island; a break at first sight resembling the openings which usually lead into lagoons; but the trees stand on a steep slope, and no hollow of an ancient lagoon was perceived.

It can be seen from the attached sketch, which Lieutenant Smith from the Blossom shared with me, that the trees reached the beach near the center of the island; there's a gap that at first glance looks like the entries that usually lead into lagoons; however, the trees are on a steep slope, and no depression of an old lagoon was observed.

Beechey also remarks, that the surface of Henderson's Island is flat, and that in Queen Charlotte's Island, one of the same group, but under water, there was no lagoon, the coral having grown up everywhere to one level. The probable cause of this obliteration of the central basin or lagoon will be considered in the sequel.

Beechey also notes that the surface of Henderson's Island is flat, and that on Queen Charlotte's Island, which is part of the same group but underwater, there was no lagoon, as the coral has grown evenly to one level everywhere. The likely reason for the disappearance of the central basin or lagoon will be discussed later.

That the bed of the Pacific and Indian oceans, where atolls are frequent, must have been sinking for ages, might be inferred, says Mr. Darwin, from simply reflecting on two facts; first, that the efficient coral-building zoophytes do not flourish in the ocean at a greater depth than 120 feet; and, secondly, that there are spaces occupying areas of many hundred thousand square miles, where all the islands consist of coral, and yet none of which rise to a greater height than may be accounted for by the action of the winds and waves on broken and triturated coral. Were we to take for granted that the floor of the ocean had remained stationary from the time when the coral began to grow, we should be compelled to assume that an incredible number of submarine mountains of vast height (for the ocean is always deep, and often unfathomable between the different atolls) had all come to within 120 feet of the surface, and yet no one mountain had risen above water. But no sooner do we admit the theory of subsidence, than this great, difficulty vanishes. However varied may have been the altitude of different islands, or the separate peaks of particular mountain-chains, all may have been reduced to one uniform level by the gradual submergence of the loftiest points, and the additions made to the calcareous cappings of the less elevated summits as they subsided to great depths.

That the floor of the Pacific and Indian oceans, where atolls are common, must have been sinking for a long time can be inferred, says Mr. Darwin, by considering two facts: first, that the coral-building creatures can only thrive in ocean depths of up to 120 feet; and second, that there are vast areas, covering hundreds of thousands of square miles, where all the islands are made of coral, yet none rise higher than what can be explained by the effects of wind and waves on broken coral. If we assume that the ocean floor has remained stable since the coral began to grow, we would have to believe that an unbelievable number of underwater mountains of significant height (since the ocean is always deep and often immeasurable between atolls) have all come within 120 feet of the surface, yet not a single mountain has emerged above water. However, once we accept the theory of subsidence, this major issue disappears. Regardless of the varying heights of different islands or the individual peaks of certain mountain ranges, they could all have been leveled uniformly by the gradual sinking of the tallest points and the buildup of coral on the lower points as they descended to great depths.

790 Openings into the lagoons.—In the general description of atolls and encircling reefs, it was mentioned that there is almost always a deep narrow passage opening into the lagoon, or into the still water between the reef and the shore, which is kept open by the efflux of the sea as the tide goes down.

790 Openings into the lagoons.—In the overall description of atolls and surrounding reefs, it was noted that there is almost always a deep, narrow passage leading into the lagoon, or into the calm water between the reef and the shore, which is kept clear by the outgoing sea as the tide recedes.

The origin of this channel must, according to the theory of subsidence before explained, be traced back to causes which were in action during the existence of the encircling reef, and when an island or mountain-top rose within it, for such a reef precedes the atoll in the order of formation. Now in those islands in the Pacific, which are large enough to feed small rivers, there is generally an opening or channel in the surrounding coral reef at the point where the stream of fresh water enters the sea. The depth of these channels rarely exceeds twenty-five feet; and they may be attributed, says Captain Beechey, to the aversion of the lithophytes to fresh water, and to the probable absence of the mineral matter of which they construct their habitations.1131

The origin of this channel, according to the previously explained theory of subsidence, should be traced back to causes that were at work during the time the surrounding reef existed, and when an island or mountain top emerged within it, since such a reef comes before the atoll in the formation sequence. In those larger islands in the Pacific that are capable of sustaining small rivers, there is usually an opening or channel in the surrounding coral reef where the freshwater stream meets the sea. The depth of these channels rarely exceeds twenty-five feet; and Captain Beechey attributes them to the dislike of lithophytes for freshwater and the likely lack of the mineral substances they use to build their habitats.1131

Mr. Darwin, however, has shown, that mud at the bottom of river-courses is far more influential than the freshness of the water in preventing the growth of the polypi, for the walls which inclose the openings are perpendicular, and do not slant off gradually, as would be the case, if the nature of the element presented the only obstacle to the increase of the coral-building animals.

Mr. Darwin, however, has demonstrated that the mud at the bottom of riverbeds plays a much bigger role than the fresh water in stopping the growth of the polyps. This is because the walls surrounding the openings are vertical and do not gradually slope off, which would be the case if the characteristics of the environment were the only barrier to the increase of the coral-building creatures.

When a breach has thus been made in the reef, it will be prevented from closing up by the efflux of the sea at low tides; for it is sufficient that a reef should rise a few feet above low-water mark to cause the waters to collect in the lagoon at high tide, and when the sea falls, to rush out at one or more points where the reef happens to be lowest or weakest. This event is strictly analogous to that witnessed in our estuaries, where a body of salt water accumulated during the flow issues with great velocity at the ebb of the tide, and scours out or keeps open a deep passage through the bar, which is almost always formed at the mouth of a river. At first there are probably many openings, but the growth of the coral tends to obstruct all those which do not serve as the principal channels of discharge; so that their number is gradually reduced to a few, and often finally to one. The fact observed universally, that the principal opening fronts a considerable valley in the encircled island, between the shores of which and the outer reef there is often deep water, scarcely leaves any doubt as to the real origin of the channel in all those countless atolls where the nucleus of land has vanished.

When a break occurs in the reef, it won't close up due to the outgoing sea at low tides; it's enough for a reef to be just a few feet above the low-water mark for water to gather in the lagoon at high tide. When the sea level drops, the water rushes out at one or more points where the reef is lowest or weakest. This is similar to what we see in our estuaries, where a body of saltwater that accumulated during high tide flows out rapidly as the tide goes out, carving out or keeping open a deep passage through the bar that typically forms at the mouth of a river. Initially, there are likely many openings, but as coral grows, it tends to block all the ones that aren’t the main channels for water to exit, gradually reducing their number to just a few, and often to just one. It's universally observed that the main opening faces a significant valley on the island, where there is usually deep water between the shores and the outer reef, which leaves little doubt about the actual origin of the channel in all those countless atolls where the land has disappeared.

Size of atolls and barrier reefs.—In regard to the dimensions of atolls, it was stated that some of the smallest observed by Beechey in the Pacific were only a mile in diameter. If their external slope under water equals upon an average an angle of 45°, then would such an atoll at the depth of half a mile, or 2640 feet, have a diameter of two miles. Hence it would appear that there must be a tendency in every atoll to 791 grow smaller, except in those cases where oscillations of level enlarge the base on which the coral grows by throwing down a talus of detrital matter all round the original cone of limestone.

Size of atolls and barrier reefs.—When it comes to the size of atolls, it was noted that some of the smallest seen by Beechey in the Pacific were just a mile across. If their underwater slope averages an angle of 45°, then at a depth of half a mile, or 2640 feet, such an atoll would have a diameter of two miles. Therefore, it seems that every atoll tends to 791 shrink, except in situations where level changes expand the base that the coral grows on by depositing a pile of debris all around the original limestone cone.

Bow Island is described by Captain Beechey as seventy miles in circumference, and thirty in its greatest diameter, but we have seen that some of the Maldives are much larger.

Bow Island is described by Captain Beechey as having a circumference of seventy miles and a maximum diameter of thirty miles, but we've noted that some of the Maldives are much larger.

As the shore of an island or continent which is subsiding will recede from a coral reef at a slow or rapid rate according as the surface of the land has a steep or gentle slope, we cannot measure the thickness of the coral by its distance from the coast; yet, as a general rule, those reefs which are farthest from the land imply the greatest amount of subsidence. We learn from Flinders, that the barrier reef of north-eastern Australia is in some places seventy miles from the mainland, and it should seem that a calcareous formation is there in progress 1000 miles long from north to south, with a breadth varying from twenty to seventy miles. It may not, indeed, be continuous over this vast area, for doubtless innumerable islands have been submerged one after another between the reef and mainland, like some which still remain, as, for example, Murray's Islands, lat. 9° 54' S. We are also told that some parts of the gulf inclosed within a barrier are 400 feet deep, so that the efficient rock-building corals cannot be growing there, and in other parts of it islands appear encircled by reefs.

As the shoreline of an island or continent that is sinking moves away from a coral reef at either a slow or fast pace—depending on whether the land has a steep or gentle slope—we can't determine the thickness of the coral based solely on its distance from the coast. However, as a general rule, reefs that are farther from the land usually indicate a greater level of subsidence. According to Flinders, the barrier reef in northeastern Australia is, in some places, seventy miles away from the mainland, and it seems that a calcareous formation is developing there that is about 1,000 miles long from north to south, with a width ranging from twenty to seventy miles. It's possible that this formation isn't continuous over such a vast area since countless islands have likely been submerged one after another between the reef and the mainland, similar to some that still exist, like Murray's Islands at lat. 9° 54' S. Additionally, we learn that some parts of the gulf enclosed within the barrier are 400 feet deep, meaning that the rock-forming corals likely cannot grow there, while in other areas, islands appear surrounded by reefs.

It will follow as one of the consequences of the theory already explained that, provided the bottom of the sea does not sink too fast to allow the zoophytes to build upwards at the same pace, the thickness of coral will be great in proportion to the rapidity of subsidence, so that if one area sinks two feet while another sinks one, the mass of coral in the first area will be double that in the second. But the downward movement must in general have been very slow and uniform, or where intermittent, must have consisted of a great number of depressions, each of slight amount, otherwise the bottom of the sea would have been carried down faster than the corals could build upwards, and the island or continent would be permanently submerged, having reached a depth of 120 or 150 feet, at which the effective reef-constructing zoophytes cease to live. If, then, the subsidence required to account for all the existing atolls must have amounted to three or four thousand feet, or even sometimes more, we are brought to the conclusion that there has been a slow and gradual sinking to this enormous extent. Such an inference is perfectly in harmony with views which the grand scale of denudation, everywhere observable in the older rocks, has led geologists to adopt in reference to upward movements. They must also have been gradual and continuous throughout indefinite ages to allow the waves and currents of the ocean to operate with adequate power.

It follows from the previously explained theory that if the sea floor doesn’t sink too quickly for the zoophytes to keep building upwards at the same rate, the thickness of coral will be greater the faster the area sinks. So, if one area sinks two feet while another sinks one foot, the coral mass in the first area will be double that of the second. However, the downward movement must generally have been very slow and consistent, or if it was occasional, it must have involved many small depressions, otherwise, the sea floor would have gone down faster than the corals could build up, resulting in the island or continent being permanently submerged at a depth of 120 to 150 feet, where the reef-building zoophytes can no longer survive. If the subsidence required to explain all the existing atolls must have been three or four thousand feet, or sometimes even more, we conclude that there has been a slow and gradual sinking of this massive extent. This inference aligns perfectly with the perspectives that the large-scale erosion observed in older rocks has led geologists to adopt regarding upward movements. These must also have occurred gradually and continuously over extremely long periods to allow the ocean's waves and currents to exert sufficient power.

The map constructed by Mr. Darwin to display at one view the geographical position of all the coral reefs throughout the globe is of the highest geological interest (see above, p. 351.), leading to splendid generalizations, when we have once embraced the theory that all atolls 792 and barrier reefs indicate recent subsidence, while the presence of fringing reefs proves the land to be stationary or rising. These two classes of coral formations are depicted by different colors; and one of the striking facts brought to light by the same classification of coral formations is the absence of active volcanoes in the areas of subsidence, and their frequent presence in the areas of elevation. The only supposed exception to this remarkable coincidence at the time when Mr. Darwin wrote, in 1842, was the volcano of Torres Strait, at the northern point of Australia, placed on the borders of an area of subsidence; but it has been since proved that this volcano has no existence.

The map created by Mr. Darwin to show the geographical locations of all the coral reefs around the world is extremely significant for geology (see above, p. 351.). It leads to impressive generalizations, especially when we accept the theory that all atolls and barrier reefs indicate recent sinking, while the presence of fringing reefs suggests that the land is stable or rising. These two types of coral formations are represented in different colors. One striking fact revealed by this classification of coral formations is the lack of active volcanoes in areas of subsidence, and their common occurrence in areas of elevation. The only supposed exception to this interesting pattern when Mr. Darwin wrote in 1842 was the volcano in Torres Strait, at the northern tip of Australia, located on the edge of a subsiding area; however, it has since been shown that this volcano does not exist.

We see, therefore, an evident connection, first, between the bursting forth every now and then of volcanic matter through rents and fissures, and the expansion or forcing outwards of the earth's crust, and, secondly, between a dormant and less energetic development of subterranean heat, and an amount of subsidence sufficiently great to cause mountains to disappear over the broad face of the ocean, leaving only small and scattered lagoon islands, or groups of atolls, to indicate the spots where those mountains once stood.

We can clearly see a connection, first, between the occasional eruption of volcanic material through cracks and fissures, and the expansion or pushing outward of the earth's crust. Secondly, there's a link between a quiet and less intense buildup of underground heat and a significant amount of sinking that can lead to mountains vanishing beneath the ocean, leaving behind only small scattered lagoon islands or groups of atolls to mark the places where those mountains used to be.

On a review of the differently-colored reefs on the map alluded to, it will be seen that there are large spaces in which upheaval, and others in which depression prevails, and these are placed alternately, while there are a few smaller areas where movements of oscillation occur. Thus if we commence with the western shores of South America, between the summit of the Andes and the Pacific (a region of earthquakes and active volcanoes), we find signs of recent elevation, not attested indeed by coral formations, which are wanting there, but by upraised banks of marine shells. Then proceeding westward, we traverse a deep ocean without islands, until we come to a band of atolls and encircled islands, including the Dangerous and Society archipelagoes, and constituting an area of subsidence more than 4000 miles long and 600 broad. Still farther, in the same direction, we reach the chain of islands to which the New Hebrides, Salomon, and New Ireland belong, where fringing reefs and masses of elevated coral indicate another area of upheaval. Again, to the westward of the New Hebrides we meet with the encircling reef of New Caledonia and the great Australian barrier, implying a second area of subsidence.

On reviewing the differently colored reefs on the mentioned map, it becomes clear that there are large sections where uplift occurs, and others where sinking is predominant, with these areas placed alternately. There are also a few smaller zones where oscillation happens. Starting with the western shores of South America, between the peaks of the Andes and the Pacific Ocean (a region known for earthquakes and active volcanoes), we observe signs of recent uplift, not verified by coral formations, which are absent there, but by raised banks of marine shells. Continuing westward, we pass through a vast ocean without islands until we reach a stretch of atolls and surrounded islands, including the Dangerous and Society archipelagos, forming an area of subsidence more than 4,000 miles long and 600 miles wide. Further in the same direction, we arrive at the chain of islands that includes the New Hebrides, Solomon Islands, and New Ireland, where fringing reefs and large masses of elevated coral indicate another area of uplift. Again, to the west of the New Hebrides, we encounter the encircling reef of New Caledonia and the great Australian barrier, suggesting a second area of subsidence.

The only objection deserving attention which has hitherto been advanced against the theory of atolls, as before explained (p. 759.), is that proposed by Mr. Maclaren.1132 "On the outside," he observes, "of coral reefs very highly inclined, no bottom is sometimes found with a line of 2000 or 3000 feet, and this is by no means a rare case. It follows that the reef ought to have this thickness; and Mr. Darwin's diagrams show that he understood it so. Now, if such masses of coral exist under the sea, they ought somewhere to be found on terra firma; for there is evidence that all the lands yet visited by geologists, have been at one 793 time submerged. But neither in the great volcanic chain, extending from Sumatra to Japan, nor in the West Indies, nor in any other region yet explored, has a bed or formation of coral even 500 feet thick been discovered, so far as we know."

The only objection worth considering that has been raised against the theory of atolls, as explained earlier (p. 759.), is the one proposed by Mr. Maclaren.1132 "On the outer side," he points out, "of coral reefs that are very steep, no bottom is sometimes found with a line of 2000 or 3000 feet, and this isn't a rare occurrence. This means that the reef should have this thickness; and Mr. Darwin's diagrams show that he understood this. Now, if such large masses of coral exist underwater, they should be found somewhere on terra firma; because there is evidence that all the lands examined by geologists have at one point been submerged. However, neither in the massive volcanic chain stretching from Sumatra to Japan, nor in the West Indies, nor in any other region explored so far, has a bed or formation of coral even 500 feet thick been found, as far as we know."

When considering this objection, it is evident that the first question we have to deal with is, whether geologists have not already discovered calcareous masses of the required thickness and structure, or precisely such as the upheaval of atolls might be expected to expose to view? We are called upon, in short, to make up our minds both as to the internal composition of the rocks that must result from the growth of corals, whether in lagoon islands or barrier reefs, and the external shape which the reefs would retain when upraised gradually to a vast height,—a task by no means so easy as some may imagine. If the reader has pictured to himself large masses of entire corals, piled one upon another, for a thickness of several thousand feet, he unquestionably mistakes altogether the nature of the accumulations now in progress. In the first place, the strata at present forming very extensively over the bottom of the ocean, within such barrier reefs as those of Australia and New Caledonia, are known to consist chiefly of horizontal layers of calcareous sediment, while here and there an intermixture must occur of the detritus of granitic and other rocks brought down by rivers from the adjoining lands, or washed from sea-cliffs by the waves and currents. Secondly, in regard to atolls, the stone-making polypifers grow most luxuriantly on the outer edge of the island, to a thickness of a few feet only. Beyond this margin broken pieces of coral and calcareous sand are strewed by the breakers over a steep seaward slope, and as the subsidence continues the next coating of live coral does not grow vertically over the first layer, but on a narrow annular space within it, the reef, as was before stated (p. 761), constantly contracting its dimensions as it sinks. Thirdly, within the lagoon the accumulation of calcareous matter is chiefly sedimentary, a kind of chalky mud derived from the decay of the softer corallines, with a mixture of calcareous sand swept by the winds and waves from the surrounding circular reef. Here and there, but only in partial clumps, are found living corals, which grow in the middle of the lagoon, and mixed with fine mud and sand, a great variety of shells, and fragments of testacea and echinoderms.

When we think about this objection, it's clear that the first question we need to address is whether geologists have already found calcareous masses that are thick and structured just like what we would expect to see from the uplift of atolls. In short, we need to determine both the internal composition of the rocks formed by coral growth, whether in lagoon islands or barrier reefs, and the external shape these reefs would keep when gradually lifted to a great height—something that's not as straightforward as it may seem. If you have imagined large masses of entire corals stacked on top of each other for thousands of feet, you are likely misunderstanding the nature of the ongoing accumulations. First, the layers currently forming extensively on the ocean floor within barrier reefs like those of Australia and New Caledonia are primarily made up of horizontal layers of calcareous sediment, with some mixture of debris from granitic and other rocks carried by rivers from nearby land or washed from sea cliffs by waves and currents. Second, regarding atolls, the coral-building polyps flourish mostly on the outer edge of the island, but only to a thickness of a few feet. Beyond this edge, broken coral pieces and calcareous sand are scattered by the breakers over a steep slope towards the sea, and as the subsidence continues, the next layer of live coral doesn’t grow directly on top of the first layer but instead on a narrow inner ring within it, with the reef continuously getting smaller as it sinks. Third, within the lagoon, the buildup of calcareous material is largely sedimentary, consisting of a kind of chalky mud that results from the decay of softer corals, mixed with calcareous sand blown in by the wind and waves from the surrounding circular reef. Occasionally, but only in scattered clumps, living corals can be found growing in the middle of the lagoon, mixed with fine mud and sand, a wide variety of shells, and fragments of other marine life.

We owe to Lieutenant Nelson the discovery that in the Bermudas the calcareous mud resulting from the decomposition of the softer corallines is absolutely undistinguishable when dried from the ordinary white chalk of Europe,1133 and this mud is carried to great distances by currents, and spread far and wide over the floor of the ocean. We also have opportunities of seeing in upraised atolls, such as Elizabeth Island, Tonga, and Hapai, which rise above the level of the sea to heights varying from ten to eighty feet, that the rocks of which they consist do not differ in structure or in the state of preservation of their included zoophytes and 794 shells from some of the oldest limestones known to the geologist. Captain Beechey remarks that the dead coral in Elizabeth Island is more or less porous and honeycombed at the surface, and hardening into a compact rock which has the fracture of secondary limestone.1134

We owe it to Lieutenant Nelson to discover that in the Bermudas, the calcareous mud from the breakdown of softer corallines is completely indistinguishable from the regular white chalk found in Europe when dried,1133 and this mud gets carried over long distances by currents and spreads widely across the ocean floor. We also have the chance to observe in elevated atolls, like Elizabeth Island, Tonga, and Hapai, which rise above sea level to heights between ten and eighty feet, that the rocks they are made of do not differ in structure or in the condition of their included zoophytes and 794 shells from some of the oldest limestones recognized by geologists. Captain Beechey notes that the dead coral in Elizabeth Island is somewhat porous and honeycombed on the surface, hardening into a dense rock that fractures like secondary limestone.1134

The island of Pulo Nias, off Sumatra (see Map, fig. 39. p. 351), which is about 3000 feet high, is described by Dr. Jack as being overspread by coral and large shells of the Chama (Tridacna) gigas, which rest on quartzose and arenaceous rocks, at various levels from the sea-coast to the summit of the highest hills.

The island of Pulo Nias, off Sumatra (see Map, fig. 39. p. 351), which is about 3000 feet high, is described by Dr. Jack as being covered with coral and large shells of the Chama (Tridacna) gigas, which rest on quartz and sandy rocks, at various heights from the sea level to the top of the tallest hills.

The cliffs of the island of Timor in the Indian Ocean are composed, says Mr. Jukes, of a raised coral reef abounding in Astræa, Meandrina, and Porites, with shells of Strombus, Conus, Nerita, Arca, Pecten, Venus, and Lucina. On a ledge about 150 feet above the sea, a Tridacna (or large clam shell), two feet across, was found bedded in the rock with closed valves, just as they are often seen in barrier reefs. This formation in the islands of Sandlewood, Sumbawa, Madura, and Java, where it is exposed in sea cliffs, was found to be from 200 to 300 feet thick, and is believed to ascend to much greater heights in the interior. It has usually the form of a "chalk-like" rock, white when broken, but in the weathered surface turning nearly black.1135

The cliffs of Timor Island in the Indian Ocean are made up, according to Mr. Jukes, of a raised coral reef filled with Astræa, Meandrina, and Porites, along with shells from Strombus, Conus, Nerita, Arca, Pecten, Venus, and Lucina. On a ledge about 150 feet above the sea, a Tridacna (or giant clam shell), measuring two feet across, was found embedded in the rock with its valves closed, just like what is often seen in barrier reefs. This formation, found in the islands of Sandlewood, Sumbawa, Madura, and Java, where it is exposed in sea cliffs, was discovered to be 200 to 300 feet thick, and it is thought to extend to much greater heights in the interior. It typically has a "chalk-like" rock appearance, white when broken, but turning nearly black on the weathered surface.1135

It appears, therefore, premature to assert that there are no recent coral formations uplifted to great heights, for we are only beginning to be acquainted with the geological structure of the rocks of equatorial regions. Some of the upraised islands, such as Elizabeth and Queen Charlotte, in the Pacific, although placed in regions of atolls, are described by Captain Beechey and others as flat-topped, and exhibiting no traces of lagoons. In explanation of the fact, we may presume that after they had been sinking for ages, the descending movement was relaxed; and while it was in the course of being converted into an ascending one, the ground remained for a long season almost stationary, in which case the corals within the lagoon would build up to the surface, and reach the level already attained by those on the margin of the reef. In this manner the lagoon would be effaced, and the island acquire a flat summit.

It seems, therefore, premature to claim that there are no recent coral formations raised to significant heights, as we are just starting to understand the geological structure of rocks in equatorial regions. Some of the raised islands, like Elizabeth and Queen Charlotte in the Pacific, even though located in atoll regions, are described by Captain Beechey and others as having flat tops and showing no signs of lagoons. To explain this, we can assume that after they had been sinking for ages, the sinking stopped; and while it was transitioning to an upward movement, the ground stayed relatively stable for a long time. In this case, the corals within the lagoon would build up to the surface, reaching the same level as those on the edge of the reef. This process would eliminate the lagoon and give the island a flat top.

It may, however, be thought strange that many examples have not been noticed of fringing reefs uplifted above the level of the sea. Mr. Darwin, indeed, cites one instance where the reef preserved, on dry land in the Mauritius, its peculiar moat-like structure; but they ought, he says, to be of rare occurrence, for in the case of atolls or of barrier or fringing reefs, the characteristic outline must usually be destroyed by denudation as soon as a reef begins to rise; since it is immediately exposed to the action of the breakers, and the large and conspicuous corals on the outer rim of the atoll or barrier are the first to be destroyed and to fall to the bottom of vertical and undermined cliffs. After slow and continued 795 upheaval a wreck alone can remain of the original reef. If, therefore, says Mr. Darwin, "at some period as far in futurity as the secondary rocks are in the past, the bed of the Pacific with its atolls and barrier reefs should be converted into a continent, we may conceive that scarcely any or none of the existing reefs would be preserved, but only widely spread strata of calcareous matter derived from their wear and tear."1136

It may seem odd that there haven't been many examples noted of fringing reefs that have been uplifted above sea level. Mr. Darwin does mention one case where a reef in Mauritius maintained its unique moat-like structure while being on dry land, but he argues that such occurrences should be quite rare. In the case of atolls or barrier or fringing reefs, the typical shape is usually lost to erosion as soon as the reef starts to rise. This is because it becomes immediately exposed to the action of the waves, and the large, noticeable corals on the outer edge of the atoll or barrier are the first to get destroyed, falling down from the steep and eroded cliffs. After a slow and ongoing uplift, only a remnant of the original reef might be left. Therefore, Mr. Darwin states, "if at some point far in the future, as far ahead as the secondary rocks are in the past, the Pacific seabed along with its atolls and barrier reefs turns into a continent, we can imagine that barely any, if any, of the existing reefs would remain, just a broad spread of calcareous material resulting from their erosion."795

When it is urged in support of the objection before stated (p. 767), that the theory of atolls by subsidence implies the accumulation of calcareous formations 2000 or 3000 feet thick, it must be conceded that this estimate of the minimum density of the deposits is by no means exaggerated. On the contrary, when we consider that the space over which atolls are scattered in Polynesia and the Indian oceans may be compared to the whole continent of Asia, we cannot but infer from analogy that the differences in level in so vast an area have amounted, antecedently to subsidence, to 5000 or even a greater number of feet. Whatever was the difference in height between the loftiest and lowest of the original mountains or mountainous islands on which the different atolls are based, that difference must represent the thickness of coral which has now reduced all of them to one level. Flinders, therefore, by no means exaggerated the volume of the limestone, which he conceived to have been the work of coral animals; he was merely mistaken as to the manner in which they were enabled to build reefs in an unfathomed ocean.

When it is argued in support of the objection previously mentioned (p. 767), that the theory of atolls formed by subsidence suggests the buildup of calcareous formations 2000 or 3000 feet thick, it's important to acknowledge that this estimate of the minimum density of the deposits is not exaggerated at all. In fact, considering that the area where atolls are spread across Polynesia and the Indian Oceans can be compared to the entire continent of Asia, we can infer from analogy that the differences in elevation across such a vast area must have been, prior to subsidence, at least 5000 feet or more. Whatever the height difference was between the tallest and the lowest original mountains or islands on which the various atolls are based, that difference must represent the thickness of the coral that has since leveled them all. Therefore, Flinders definitely did not overstate the amount of limestone, which he believed was created by coral animals; he was just mistaken about how they were able to build reefs in such deep waters.

But is it reasonable to expect, after the waste caused by denudation, that calcareous masses, gradually upheaved in an open sea, should retain such vast thicknesses? Or may not the limestones of the cretaceous and oolitic epochs, which attain in the Alps and Pyrenees a density of 3000 or 4000 feet, and are in great part made up of coralline and shelly matter, present us with a true geological counterpart of the recent coral reefs of equatorial seas?

But is it realistic to think that, after the loss caused by erosion, calcareous masses, slowly pushed up in an open ocean, would maintain such large thicknesses? Or could the limestones from the Cretaceous and Oolitic periods, which reach densities of 3000 to 4000 feet in the Alps and Pyrenees and are largely composed of coral and shell material, actually offer us a genuine geological equivalent to the recent coral reefs found in equatorial seas?

Before we attach serious importance to arguments founded on negative evidence, and opposed to a theory which so admirably explains a great variety of complicated phenomena, we ought to remember that the upheaval to the height of 4000 feet of atolls in which the coralline limestone would be 4000 feet thick, implies, first, a slow subsidence of 4000 feet, and, secondly, an elevation of the same amount. Even if the reverse or ascending movement began the instant the downward one ceased, we must allow a great lapse of ages for the accomplishment of the whole operation. We must also assume that at the commencement of the period in question, the equatorial regions were as fitted as now for the support of reef-building zoophytes. This postulate would demand the continuance of a complicated variety of conditions throughout a much longer period than they are usually persistent in one place.

Before we take arguments based on negative evidence too seriously, especially against a theory that effectively explains a wide range of complex phenomena, we should keep in mind that the uplift of atolls to an elevation of 4000 feet, where the coralline limestone would be 4000 feet thick, requires, first, a gradual sinking of 4000 feet and, second, a rise of the same distance. Even if the upward movement started immediately after the downward one stopped, we would still need to allow a significant amount of time for the entire process to occur. We must also assume that at the beginning of this period, the equatorial regions were just as capable of supporting reef-building organisms as they are today. This assumption would require a prolonged variety of conditions to persist for a much longer time than is typically seen in one location.

To show the difficulty of speculating on the permanence of the geographical and climatal circumstances requisite for the growth of reef-building 796 corals, we have only to state the fact that there are no reefs in the Atlantic, off the west coast of Africa, nor among the islands of the Gulf of Guinea, nor in St. Helena, Ascension, the Cape Verdes, or St. Paul's. With the exception of Bermuda, there is not a single coral reef in the central expanse of the Atlantic, although in some parts the waves, as at Ascension, are charged to excess with calcareous matter. This capricious distribution of coral reefs is probably owing to the absence of fit stations for the reef-building polypifers, other organic beings in those regions obtaining in the great struggle for existence a mastery over them. Their absence, in whatever manner it be accounted for, should put us on our guard against expecting upraised reefs at all former geological epochs, similar to those now in progress.

To illustrate the challenge of predicting the stability of the geographical and climatic conditions needed for the growth of reef-building corals, we just need to point out that there are no reefs in the Atlantic, off the west coast of Africa, nor among the islands of the Gulf of Guinea, nor in St. Helena, Ascension, the Cape Verdes, or St. Paul's. With the exception of Bermuda, there isn't a single coral reef in the central Atlantic, even though in some areas, like Ascension, the waves are heavily loaded with calcareous material. This unpredictable distribution of coral reefs is likely due to the absence of suitable environments for the reef-building polyps, with other organisms in those regions dominating the struggle for survival. Their lack of presence, however it may be explained, should caution us against expecting to find raised reefs from past geological periods that resemble those currently being formed.

Lime, whence derived.—Dr. Maculloch, in his system of Geology, vol. i. p. 219, expressed himself in favor of the theory of some of the earlier geologists, that all limestones have originated in organized substances. If we examine, he says, the quantity of limestone in the primary strata, it will be found to bear a much smaller proportion to the siliceous and argillaceous rocks than in the secondary; and this may have some connexion with the rarity of testaceous animals in the ancient ocean. He farther infers, that in consequence of the operations of animals, "the quantity of calcareous earth deposited in the form of mud or stone is always increasing; and that as the secondary series far exceeds the primary in this respect, so a third series may hereafter arise from the depths of the sea, which may exceed the last in the proportion of its calcareous strata."

Lime, where it comes from.—Dr. Maculloch, in his Geology textbook, vol. i. p. 219, supported the idea of some early geologists that all limestones originated from living organisms. He notes that if we look at the amount of limestone in the primary layers, it will show a much smaller ratio compared to the siliceous and clay rocks than in the secondary layers; this might relate to the scarcity of shellfish in the ancient ocean. He further argues that due to the activities of animals, "the amount of calcium carbonate deposited as mud or stone is always increasing; and since the secondary layers greatly outnumber the primary in this regard, a third layer may eventually form from the ocean depths that may surpass the previous one in the proportion of its calcium-rich layers."

If these propositions went no farther than to suggest that every particle of lime that now enters into the crust of the globe, may possibly in its turn have been subservient to the purposes of life, by entering into the composition of organized bodies, I should not deem the speculation improbable; but, when it is hinted that lime may be an animal product combined by the powers of vitality from some simple elements, I can discover no sufficient grounds for such an hypothesis, and many facts militate against it.

If these ideas only suggested that every bit of lime that now becomes part of the Earth's crust might have once contributed to life by being part of living organisms, I wouldn't find the speculation unlikely. However, when it's suggested that lime could be an animal product formed by the forces of life from some basic elements, I see no strong evidence for such a theory, and many facts argue against it.

If a large pond be made in almost any soil, and filled with rain water, it may usually become tenanted by testacea; for carbonate of lime is almost universally diffused in small quantities. But if no calcareous matter be supplied by waters flowing from the surrounding high grounds, or by springs, no tufa or shell-marl are formed. The thin shells of one generation of mollusks decompose, so that their elements afford nutriment to the succeeding races; and it is only where a stream enters a lake, which may introduce a fresh supply of calcareous matter, or where the lake is fed by springs, that shells accumulate and form marl.

If a large pond is created in almost any type of soil and filled with rainwater, it will often be inhabited by shellfish since calcium carbonate is generally found in small amounts everywhere. However, if no calcium-rich materials come from the surrounding higher land or springs, then no tufa or shell-marl will form. The thin shells from one generation of mollusks break down, providing nutrients for the next generations. Shells only build up and create marl when a stream flows into the lake, bringing in more calcium, or when the lake is supplied by springs.

All the lakes in Forfarshire which have produced deposits of shell-marl have been the sites of springs, which still evolve much carbonic acid, and a small quantity of carbonate of lime. But there is no marl in Loch Fithie, near Forfar, where there are no springs, although that lake is surrounded by these calcareous deposits, and although, in every other respect, the site is favorable to the accumulation of aquatic testacea.

All the lakes in Forfarshire that have produced deposits of shell-marl have been locations of springs, which still release a lot of carbon dioxide and a small amount of calcium carbonate. However, there is no marl in Loch Fithie, near Forfar, where there are no springs, even though that lake is surrounded by these calcareous deposits, and even though, in every other way, the area is suitable for the accumulation of aquatic shells.

797 We find those Charæ which secrete the largest quantity of calcareous matter in their stems to abound near springs impregnated with carbonate of lime. We know that, if the common hen be deprived altogether of calcareous nutriment, the shells of her eggs will become of too slight a consistency to protect the contents; and some birds eat chalk greedily during the breeding season.

797 We find that the Charæ, which release the most calcium material in their stems, are plentiful near springs rich in calcium carbonate. We know that if a common hen is completely deprived of calcium in her diet, the shells of her eggs will be too weak to protect their contents; and some birds eat chalk eagerly during the breeding season.

If, on the other hand, we turn to the phenomena of inorganic nature, we observe that, in volcanic countries, there is an enormous evolution of carbonic acid, either free, in a gaseous form, or mixed with water; and the springs of such districts are usually impregnated with carbonate of lime in great abundance. No one who has travelled in Tuscany, through the region of extinct volcanos and its confines, or who has seen the map constructed by Targioni (1827), to show the principal sites of mineral springs, can doubt, for a moment, that if this territory was submerged beneath the sea, it might supply materials for the most extensive coral reefs. The importance of these springs is not to be estimated by the magnitude of the rocks which they have thrown down on the slanting sides of hills, although of these alone large cities might be built, nor by a coating of travertin that covers the soil in some districts for miles in length. The greater part of the calcareous matter passes down in a state of solution to the sea, and in all countries the rivers which flow from chalk and other marly and calcareous rocks carry down vast quantities of lime into the ocean. Lime is also one of the component parts of augite and other volcanic and hypogene minerals, and when these decompose is set free, and may then find its way in a state of solution to the sea.

If we look at the phenomena of inorganic nature, we notice that in volcanic regions, there's a significant release of carbon dioxide, either as a gas or mixed with water. The springs in these areas often have a lot of limestone dissolved in them. Anyone who has traveled through Tuscany, in the area of extinct volcanoes and its surroundings, or who has seen the map created by Targioni (1827) showing the main sites of mineral springs, can hardly doubt that if this land were submerged underwater, it could provide materials for extensive coral reefs. The importance of these springs isn't measured by the size of the rocks they’ve deposited on the slopes of hills, even though those alone could be used to build large cities, nor by the layer of travertine that stretches for miles across some areas. Most of the calcareous material is dissolved and makes its way to the sea, and in every country, rivers flowing from chalk and other limestone rocks carry large amounts of lime into the ocean. Lime is also a key part of augite and other volcanic and deep Earth minerals, and when they break down, lime is released and could then dissolve into the sea.

The lime, therefore, contained generally in sea water, and secreted so plentifully by the testacea and corals of the Pacific, may have been derived either from springs rising up in the bed of the ocean, or from rivers fed by calcareous springs, or impregnated with lime derived from disintegrated rocks, both volcanic and hypogene. If this be admitted, the greater proportion of limestone in the more modern formations as compared to the most ancient, will be explained, for springs in general hold no argillaceous, and but a small quantity of siliceous matter in solution, but they are continually subtracting calcareous matter from the inferior rocks. The constant transfer, therefore, of carbonate of lime from the lower or older portions of the earth's crust to the surface, must cause at all periods and throughout an indefinite succession of geological epochs, a preponderance of calcareous matter in the newer as contrasted with the older formations.

The lime found in sea water and produced abundantly by shellfish and corals in the Pacific might come from springs that rise from the ocean floor or from rivers that are fed by calcareous springs or that contain lime from weathered rocks, both volcanic and mineral-based. If this is accepted, the larger amount of limestone in more recent formations compared to the oldest ones can be understood, because springs typically do not hold much clay and only a small amount of silica in solution, while constantly removing calcareous material from the underlying rocks. This ongoing process of transferring calcium carbonate from the deeper, older layers of the earth's crust to the surface must lead to a higher concentration of calcareous material in newer formations compared to older ones throughout various geological periods.

THE END.

CONCLUDING REMARKS.

In the concluding chapters of the first book, I examined in detail a great variety of arguments which have been adduced to prove the distinctness of the state of the earth's crust at remote and recent epochs. Among other supposed proofs of this distinctness, the dearth of calcareous matter, in the ancient rocks above adverted to, might have been considered. But it would have been endless to enumerate all the objections urged against those geologists who represent the course of nature at the earliest periods as resembling in all essential circumstances the state of things now established. We have seen that, in opposition to this doctrine, a strong desire has been manifested to discover in the ancient rocks the signs of an epoch when the planet was uninhabited, and when its surface was in a chaotic condition and uninhabitable. The opposite opinion, indeed, that the oldest of the rocks now visible may be the last monuments of an antecedent era in which living beings may already have peopled the land and water, has been declared to be equivalent to the assumption that there never was a beginning to the present order of things.

In the final chapters of the first book, I looked closely at a wide range of arguments that have been put forward to show the differences in the state of the earth's crust during ancient and recent times. One of the supposed pieces of evidence for this distinction is the lack of calcium-rich materials in the ancient rocks mentioned earlier. However, it would be endless to list all the counterarguments against those geologists who argue that the natural processes in the earliest periods were similar in all important ways to the current state of affairs. We’ve seen that there is a strong desire to find evidence in the ancient rocks of a time when the planet was uninhabited and its surface was chaotic and unfit for life. The opposing view, that the oldest visible rocks might actually be the last remnants of a prior era when life may have already existed on land and in water, has been said to imply that there was never a beginning to the current order of things.

With equal justice might an astronomer be accused of asserting that the works of creation extended throughout infinite space, because he refuses to take for granted that the remotest stars now seen in the heavens are on the utmost verge of the material universe. Every improvement of the telescope has brought thousands of new worlds into view; and it would, therefore, be rash and unphilosophical to imagine that we already survey the whole extent of the vast scheme, or that it will ever be brought within the sphere of human observation.

With equal fairness, an astronomer could be accused of claiming that the works of creation stretch across infinite space simply because they won't assume that the farthest stars visible in the sky are at the very edge of the material universe. Every advancement in telescope technology has revealed thousands of new worlds, so it would be reckless and unscientific to think that we have already observed the entire magnitude of the grand design or that it will ever be fully grasped by human observation.

But no argument can be drawn from such premises in favor of the infinity of the space that has been filled with worlds; and if the material universe has any limits, it then follows, that it must occupy a minute and infinitesimal point in infinite space.

But no argument can be made from such premises in support of the idea that space filled with worlds is infinite; and if the material universe has any boundaries, it follows that it must occupy a tiny and insignificant point in infinite space.

So if, in tracing back the earth's history, we arrive at the monuments of events which may have happened millions of ages before our times, and if we still find no decided evidence of a commencement, yet the arguments from analogy in support of the probability of a beginning remain unshaken; and if the past duration of the earth be finite, then the aggregate of geological epochs, however numerous, must constitute a mere moment of the past, a mere infinitesimal portion of eternity.

So if we look back at the earth's history and explore events that may have occurred millions of years ago, and if we still find no clear evidence of a beginning, the arguments from analogy that support the idea of a starting point remain strong. If the earth's past duration is finite, then the total amount of geological epochs, no matter how many there are, must only represent a brief moment in the past, just a tiny fraction of eternity.

It has been argued, that, as the different states of the earth's surface, and the different species by which it has been inhabited have all had their origin, and many of them their termination, so the entire series may have commenced at a certain period. It has also been urged, that, as we admit the creation of man to have occurred at a comparatively 799 modern epoch—as we concede the astonishing fact of the first introduction of a moral and intellectual being—so also we may conceive the first creation of the planet itself.

It has been suggested that just like the different states of the earth's surface and the various species that have inhabited it all have their beginnings and many have their ends, the entire series may have started at a specific point in time. It has also been pointed out that, since we accept that the creation of humans took place during a relatively recent period, and we acknowledge the incredible fact of the first arrival of a moral and intellectual being, we can also imagine the initial creation of the planet itself.

I am far from denying the weight of this reasoning from analogy; but, although it may strengthen our conviction, that the present system of change has not gone on from eternity, it cannot warrant us in presuming that we shall be permitted to behold the signs of the earth's origin, or the evidences of the first introduction into it of organic beings. We aspire in vain to assign limits to the works of creation in space, whether we examine the starry heavens, or that world of minute animalcules which is revealed to us by the microscope. We are prepared, therefore, to find that in time also the confines of the universe lie beyond the reach of mortal ken. But in whatever direction we pursue our researches, whether in time or space, we discover everywhere the clear proofs of a Creative Intelligence, and of His foresight, wisdom, and power.

I’m not denying the significance of this reasoning from analogy; however, while it may reinforce our belief that the current system of change hasn't been happening forever, it doesn't give us the right to assume we will be able to see the signs of how the Earth originated or the evidence of the first appearance of living beings. We try in vain to put limits on the works of creation in space, whether we look at the starry sky or the tiny organisms revealed to us by the microscope. So, we are ready to find that in time as well, the boundaries of the universe lie beyond what humans can know. But no matter which direction we take our research, whether in time or space, we find clear evidence of a Creative Intelligence, along with His foresight, wisdom, and power.

As geologists, we learn that it is not only the present condition of the globe which has been suited to the accommodation of myriads of living creatures, but that many former states also have been adapted to the organization and habits of prior races of beings. The disposition of the seas, continents, and islands, and the climates, have varied; the species likewise have been changed; and yet they have all been so modelled, on types analogous to those of existing plants and animals, as to indicate, throughout, a perfect harmony of design and unity of purpose. To assume that the evidence of the beginning or end of so vast a scheme lies within the reach of our philosophical inquiries, or even of our speculations, appears to be inconsistent with a just estimate of the relations which subsist between the finite powers of man and the attributes of an Infinite and Eternal Being.

As geologists, we understand that it’s not just the current state of the Earth that has supported countless living creatures; many past conditions have also been suitable for previous species. The arrangement of seas, continents, islands, and climates has changed over time, and species have evolved as well. Yet, they have all been structured in ways similar to existing plants and animals, showing a consistent harmony of design and a unified purpose throughout. To think that the evidence of the beginning or end of such a vast scheme is something we can grasp through philosophical inquiries or speculations seems unrealistic when considering the gap between human understanding and the qualities of an Infinite and Eternal Being.


GLOSSARY

OF GEOLOGICAL AND OTHER SCIENTIFIC TERMS USED IN THIS WORK.

Acephalous. The Acephala are that division of molluscous animals which, like the oyster and scallop, are without heads. The class Acephala of Cuvier comprehends many genera of animals with bivalve shells, and a few which are devoid of shells. Etym., α, a, without, and κεφαλη, cephale, the head.

Leaderless. The Acephala are a category of mollusks that, like oysters and scallops, lack heads. Cuvier's class Acephala includes many genera of animals with bivalve shells, and a few that do not have shells. Etym., α, a, without, and κεφαλη, cephale, the head.

Acidulous. Slightly acid.

Slightly acidic.

Acrogens. One of five classes into which all plants may be divided; it includes such flowerless ones as grow from the top only, and whose stems consequently do not increase materially in bulk, as Mosses, Ferns, Lycopodiums, Equisetums, &c. The trunk of a tree fern is a good example. They are also called Acrobrya. Etym., ακρον, acron, the top, and γενεσις, genesis, increase.

Acrogens. One of five categories into which all plants can be classified; it includes flowerless plants that only grow from the top, so their stems don't significantly thicken, such as Mosses, Ferns, Lycopodiums, Equisetums, etc. The trunk of a tree fern is a good example. They are also referred to as Acrobrya. Etym., ακρον, acron, the top, and γενεσις, genesis, increase.

Adipocire. A substance apparently intermediate between fat and wax, into which dead animal matter is converted when buried in the earth, and in a certain stage of decomposition. Etym., adeps, fat, and cera, wax.

Adipocere. A substance that seems to be in between fat and wax, formed when dead animal material breaks down and is buried in the ground during a certain stage of decomposition. Etym., adeps, fat, and cera, wax.

Albite. See "Felspar."

Albite. See "Feldspar."

Alembio. An apparatus for distilling.

Alembio. A distillation device.

Algæ. An order or division of the cryptogamic class of plants. The whole of the sea-weeds are comprehended under this division, and the application of the term in this work is to marine plants. Etym., alga, sea-weed.

Algae. An order or group of the cryptogamic class of plants. All seaweeds fall under this category, and in this work, the term refers specifically to marine plants. Etym., alga, seaweed.

Alluvial. The adjective of alluvium, which see.

Floodplain. The adjective for alluvium, which you can find more about.

Alluvion. Synonymous with alluvium, which see.

Alluvion. Another term for alluvium.

Alluvium. Earth, sand, gravel, stones, and other transported matter which has been washed away and thrown down by rivers, floods, or other causes upon land not permanently submerged beneath the waters of lakes or seas. Etym., alluo, to wash upon, or alluvio, an inundation.

Alluvial soil. Soil, sand, gravel, rocks, and other materials that have been carried away and deposited by rivers, floods, or other factors onto land that is not permanently underwater. Etym., alluo, to wash upon, or alluvio, a flood.

Alum-stone, Alumen, Aluminous. Alum is the base of pure clay, and strata of clay are often met with containing much iron pyrites. When the latter substance decomposes, sulphuric acid is produced, which unites with the aluminous earth of the clay to form sulphate of alumine, or common alum. Where manufactories are established for obtaining the alum, the indurated beds of clay employed are called Alum-stone.

Alum rock, Alum, Aluminum. Alum is made from pure clay, and clay layers often contain a lot of iron pyrites. When this substance breaks down, it produces sulfuric acid, which combines with the aluminous material in the clay to create sulfate of alumina, or common alum. In places where factories are set up to produce alum, the hardened clay beds used are known as Alum-stone.

Ammonite. An extinct and very numerous genus of the order of molluscous animals called Cephalopoda, allied to the modern genus Nautilus, which inhabited a chambered shell, curved like a coiled snake. Species of it are found in all geological periods of the secondary strata; but they have not been seen in the tertiary beds. They are named from their resemblance to the horns on the statues of Jupiter Ammon.

Ammonite. An extinct and highly diverse group of mollusks belonging to the order Cephalopoda, related to the modern genus Nautilus, which lived in a shell that was curved like a coiled snake. Species of ammonites have been discovered in all geological periods of the secondary strata; however, they have not been found in the tertiary layers. They are named for their resemblance to the horns on the statues of Jupiter Ammon.

Amorphous. Bodies devoid of regular form. Etym., α, a, without, and μορφη, morphe, form.

Shape-shifting. Bodies without a fixed shape. Etym., α, a, meaning without, and μορφη, morphe, meaning shape.

Amygdaloid. One of the forms of the Trap-rocks, in which agates and simple minerals appear to be scattered like almonds in a cake. Etym., αμυγδαλα, amygdala, an almond.

Amygdala. A type of trap rock where agates and simple minerals are distributed like almonds in a cake. Etym., αμυγδαλα, amygdala, an almond.

Analcime. A simple mineral of the Zeolite family, also called Cubizite, of frequent occurrence in the Trap-rocks.

Analcime. A straightforward mineral from the Zeolite family, also known as Cubizite, commonly found in trap rocks.

Analogue. A body that resembles or corresponds with another body. A recent shell of the same species as a fossil shell is the analogue of the latter.

Analog. A body that looks like or corresponds to another body. A recent shell of the same species as a fossil shell is the analogue of the latter.

Angoiosperms. A term applied to all flowering plants in which the ovules are inclosed in an ovary, and the seeds in a pericarp or covering, as in all flowering plants except those mentioned under gymnosperms and gymnogens, which see. Etym., αγγος, angos, a vessel, and σπερμα, a seed.

Flowering plants. This term refers to all flowering plants where the ovules are enclosed in an ovary, and the seeds are inside a covering known as a pericarp. This applies to all flowering plants except those categorized under gymnosperms and gymnogens, which you can refer to for more details. Etym., αγγος, angos, meaning a vessel, and σπερμα, a seed.

Anoplotherium. A fossil extinct quadruped belonging to the order Pachydermata, resembling a pig. It has received its name because the animal must have been singularly wanting in means of defence, from the form of its teeth and the absence of claws, hoofs, and horns. Etym., ανοπλος, anoplos, unarmed, and θηριον, therion, a wild beast.

Anoplotherium. A fossil extinct four-legged animal that belongs to the order Pachydermata, resembling a pig. It got its name because the animal must have been particularly defenseless, based on the shape of its teeth and the lack of claws, hooves, and horns. Etym., ανοπλος, anoplos, unarmed, and θηριον, therion, a wild beast.

Antagonist Power. Two powers in nature, the action of the one counteracting that of the other, by which a kind of equilibrium or balance is maintained, and the destructive effect prevented that would be produced by one operating without a check.

Villain Power. Two forces in nature, where the action of one counters the action of the other, creating a sort of equilibrium or balance that avoids the destructive effects that would occur if one operated unchecked.

Antennæ. The articulated horns with which the heads of insects are invariably furnished.

Antennae. The movable sensors that are always attached to the heads of insects.

Anthracite. A shining substance like black-lead; a species of mineral charcoal. Etym., ανθραξ, anthrax, coal.

Anthracite coal. A glossy substance similar to graphite; a type of mineral charcoal. Etym., ανθραξ, anthrax, coal.

Anthracotherium. A name given to an extinct quadruped, supposed to belong to the Pachydermata, the bones of which were first found in lignite and coal of the tertiary strata. Etym., ανθραξ, anthrax, coal, and θηριον, therion, wild beast.

Anthracotherium. A name for an extinct four-legged animal, believed to be part of the Pachydermata group, whose bones were first discovered in the lignite and coal deposits of the tertiary period. Etym., ανθραξ, anthrax, coal, and θηριον, therion, wild beast.

Anthropomorphous. Having a form resembling the human. Etym., ανθρωπος, anthropos, a man, and μορφη, morphe, form.

Anthropomorphic. Having a shape that looks like a human. Etym., ανθρωπος, anthropos, a man, and μορφη, morphe, form.

Antiseptic. Substances which prevent corruption in animal and vegetable matter, as common salt does, are said to be antiseptic. Etym., αντι, anti, against, and σηπω, sepo, to putrefy.

Antiseptic. Substances that stop decay in animal and plant matter, like common salt, are referred to as antiseptic. Etym., αντι, anti, against, and σηπω, sepo, to rot.

Arenaceous. Sandy. Etym., arena, sand.

Sandy. Etym., arena, sand.

Argillaceous. Clayey, composed of clay. Etym., argilla, clay.

Argillaceous. Clay-like, made of clay. Etym., argilla, clay.

Arragonite. A simple mineral, a variety of carbonate of lime, so called from having been first found in Aragon in Spain.

Aragonite. A straightforward mineral, a type of carbonate of lime, named after its discovery in Aragon, Spain.

Atolls. Coral islands of an annular form, or consisting of a circular strip or ring of coral surrounding a central lagoon.

Islands. Coral islands shaped like a ring, made up of a circular band of coral that encircles a central lagoon.

Augite. A simple mineral of a dark green, or black color, which forms a constituent part of many varieties of volcanic rocks. Name applied by Pliny to a particular mineral, from the Greek αυγη, auge, lustre.

Augite. A basic mineral that is dark green or black, which is a key component of many types of volcanic rocks. The name was used by Pliny for a specific mineral, derived from the Greek αυγη, auge, meaning shine.

Avalanches. Masses of snow which, being detached from great heights in the Alps, acquire enormous bulk by fresh accumulations as they descend; and when they fall into the valleys below often cause great destruction. They are also called lavanges and lavanches in the dialects of Switzerland.

Avalanches. Large masses of snow that break loose from high elevations in the Alps, picking up significant size with additional snowfall as they come down. When they reach the valleys below, they can cause serious destruction. They are also referred to as lavanges and lavanches in the local dialects of Switzerland.

Basalt. One of the most common varieties of the Trap-rocks. It is a dark green or black stone, composed of augite and felspar, very compact in texture, and of considerable hardness, often found in regular pillars of three or more sides called basaltic columns. Remarkable examples of this kind are seen at the Giant's Causeway, in Ireland, and at Fingal's Cave, in Staffa, one of the Hebrides. The term is used by Pliny, and is said to come from basal, an Æthiopian word signifying iron. The rock often contains much iron.

Basalt rock. It’s one of the most common types of trap rock. This stone is usually dark green or black and is made up of augite and feldspar. It has a very compact texture and is quite hard, often forming regular pillars with three or more sides known as basaltic columns. Notable examples can be seen at the Giant's Causeway in Ireland and Fingal's Cave in Staffa, one of the Hebrides. The term was used by Pliny and is thought to come from basal, an Ethiopian word meaning iron. Basalt often contains a lot of iron.

Basin" of Paris, "Basin" of London. Deposits lying in a hollow or trough, formed of older rocks; sometimes used in geology almost synonymously with "formations," to express the deposits lying in a certain cavity or depression in older rocks.

Bowl" of Paris, "Basin" of London. Deposits found in a hollow or trough, made up of older rocks; sometimes used in geology almost interchangeably with "formations," to describe the deposits located in a specific cavity or depression within older rocks.

Belemnite. An extinct genus of the order of molluscous animals called Cephalopoda, having a long, straight, and chambered conical shell. Etym., βελεμνον, belemnon, a dart.

Belemnite. An extinct genus of the class of mollusk animals known as Cephalopoda, characterized by a long, straight, chambered conical shell. Etym., βελεμνον, belemnon, a dart.

Bitumen. Mineral pitch, of which the tar-like substance which is often seen to ooze out of the Newcastle coal when on the fire, and which makes it cake, is a good example. Etym., bitumen, pitch.

Asphalt. Mineral pitch, like the tar-like substance that often seeps out of Newcastle coal when it's burning and causes it to clump, is a great example. Etym., bitumen, pitch.

Bituminous Shale. An argillaceous shale, much impregnated with bitumen, which is very common in the Coal Measures.

Shale Oil. A clay-rich shale that is heavily infused with bitumen, commonly found in the Coal Measures.

Blende. A metallic ore, a compound of the metal zinc with sulphur. It is often found in brown shining crystals; hence its name among the German miners, from the word blenden, to dazzle.

Blend. A metallic ore, a mixture of the metal zinc and sulfur. It's commonly found in shiny brown crystals; that's why it's called that by German miners, derived from the word blenden, meaning to dazzle.

Bluffs. High banks presenting a precipitous front to the sea or a river. A term used in the United States of North America.

Bluffing. Steep banks that face the sea or a river. A term used in the United States.

Botryoidal. Resembling a bunch of Grapes. Etym., βοτρυς, botrys, a bunch of grapes, and ειδος, eidos, form.

Botryoidal. Looking like a cluster of grapes. Etym., βοτρυς, botrys, a bunch of grapes, and ειδος, eidos, form.

Boulders. A provincial term for large rounded blocks of stone lying on the surface of the ground, or sometimes imbedded in loose soil, different in composition from the rocks in their vicinity, and which have been therefore transported from a distance.

Boulders. A local term for large round chunks of stone that are either on the ground's surface or sometimes stuck in loose soil, differing in composition from the surrounding rocks, indicating they have been moved from elsewhere.

Breccia. A rock composed of angular fragments connected together by lime or other mineral substance. An Italian term.

Breccia. A type of rock made up of angular pieces that are held together by lime or other minerals. It's an Italian word.

Calc Sinter. A German name for the deposits from springs holding carbonate of lime in solution—petrifying springs. Etym., kalk, lime, and sintern, to drop.

Calc Sinter. A German term for deposits from springs that hold dissolved calcium carbonate—petrifying springs. Etym., kalk, lime, and sintern, to drop.

Calcaire Grossier. An extensive stratum, or rather series of strata, found in the Paris Basin, belonging to the Eocene tertiary period. Etym., calcaire, limestone, and grossier, coarse.

Coarse Limestone. A large layer, or actually a series of layers, found in the Paris Basin, from the Eocene era. Etym., calcaire, limestone, and grossier, coarse.

Calcareous Rock. Limestone. Etym., calx, lime.

Calcareous Rock. Limestone. Etym., calx, lime.

Calcareous Spar. Crystallized carbonate of lime.

Calcareous Spar. Crystallized lime carbonate.

Carbon. An undecomposed inflammable substance, one of the simple elementary bodies. Charcoal is almost entirely composed of it. Etym., carbo, coal.

Carbon. A non-decomposed flammable substance, one of the basic elements. Charcoal is mostly made of it. Etym., carbo, coal.

Carbonate of Lime. Lime combines with great avidity with carbonic acid, a gaseous acid only obtained fluid when united with water,—and all combinations of it with other substances are called Carbonates. All limestones are carbonates of lime, and quicklime is obtained by driving off the carbonic acid by heat.

Calcium Carbonate. Lime eagerly combines with carbonic acid, a gas that only becomes liquid when mixed with water, and all combinations of it with other substances are called Carbonates. All limestones are calcium carbonates, and quicklime is produced by heating to remove the carbonic acid.

Carbonated Springs. Springs of water, containing carbonic acid gas. They are very common, especially in volcanic countries; and sometimes contain so much gas, that if a little sugar be thrown into the water it effervesces like soda-water.

Sparkling Water. Springs of water that have carbon dioxide in them. They're quite common, especially in volcanic regions, and sometimes have so much gas that if you add a bit of sugar, it fizzes like soda.

Carbonic Acid Gas. A natural gas which often issues from the ground, especially in volcanic countries. Etym., carbo, coal; because the gas is obtained by the slow burning of charcoal.

Carbon dioxide. A natural gas that frequently comes out of the ground, particularly in volcanic regions. Etym., carbo, coal; because the gas is produced by the slow combustion of charcoal.

Carboniferous. A term usually applied, in a technical sense, to an ancient group of secondary strata; but any bed containing coal may be said to be carboniferous. Etym., carbo, coal, and fero, to bear.

Carboniferous period. This term is typically used in a technical sense to refer to an ancient group of secondary rock layers; however, any layer that contains coal can be called carboniferous. Etym., carbo, coal, and fero, to bear.

Cataclysm. A deluge. Etym., κατακλυζω, catacluzo, to deluge.

Cataclysm. A flood. Etym., κατακλυζω, catacluzo, to flood.

Cephalopoda. A class of molluscous animals, having their organs of motion arranged round their head. Etym., κεφαλη, cephale, head, and ποδα, poda, feet.

Cephalopods. A class of mollusks with their movement organs arranged around their head. Etym., κεφαλη, cephale, head, and ποδα, poda, feet.

Cetacea. An order of vertebrated mammiferous animals inhabiting the sea. The whale, dolphin, and narwal are examples. Etym., cete, whale.

Whales and dolphins. An order of vertebrate marine mammals living in the ocean. Examples include the whale, dolphin, and narwhal. Etym., cete, whale.

Chalcedony. A siliceous simple mineral, uncrystallized. Agates are partly composed of chalcedony.

Chalcedony. A simple silicate mineral, not crystallized. Agates are made up, in part, of chalcedony.

Chalk. A white earthy limestone, the uppermost of the secondary series of strata.

Chalk. A white, chalky limestone, the top layer of the secondary series of rock formations.

Chert. A siliceous mineral, nearly allied to chalcedony and flint, but less homogeneous and simple in texture. A gradual passage from chert to limestone is not uncommon.

Chert. A siliceous mineral that is closely related to chalcedony and flint, but is less uniform and straightforward in texture. It's not unusual for there to be a gradual transition from chert to limestone.

Chloritic Sand. Sand colored green by an admixture of the simple mineral chlorite. Etym., χλωρυς, chlorus, green.

Chloritic Sand. Sand that appears green due to a mixture of the mineral chlorite. Etym., χλωρυς, chlorus, green.

Cleavage. Certain rocks, usually called Slate-rocks, may be cleaved into an indefinite number of thin laminæ which are parallel to each other, but which are generally not parallel to the planes of the true strata or layers of deposition. The planes of cleavage, therefore, are distinguishable from those of stratification.

Cleavage. Some rocks, often referred to as slate rocks, can be split into an unlimited number of thin layers that are parallel to one another, but are usually not aligned with the true strata or layers of deposition. As a result, the cleavage planes are different from the stratification planes.

Clinkstone, called also phonolite, a felspathic rock of the trap family, usually fissile. It is sonorous when struck with a hammer, whence its name.

Clinkstone, also known as phonolite, is a feldspar-rich rock from the trap family, typically split into layers. It produces a ringing sound when hit with a hammer, which is how it got its name.

Coal Formation. This term is generally understood to mean the same as the Coal Measures, or Carboniferous group.

Coal Creation. This term is usually understood to refer to the same thing as the Coal Measures, or the Carboniferous group.

Coleoptera. An order of insects (Beetles) which have four wings, the upper pair being crustaceous and forming a shield. Etym., κολεος, coleos, a sheath, and πτερον, pteron, a wing.

Beetles. An order of insects (Beetles) that have four wings, with the top pair being hard and acting like a shield. Etym., κολεος, coleos, a sheath, and πτερον, pteron, a wing.

Conformable. When the planes of one set of strata are generally parallel to those of another set which are in contact, they are said to be conformable. Thus the set a, b, Fig. 98, rest conformably on the inferior set c, d; but c, d rest unconformably on E.

Adaptable. When the layers of one group of rocks are generally parallel to those of another group that they touch, they are called conformable. So, the set a, b, Fig. 98, sits conformably on the lower set c, d; however, c, d sit unconformably on E.

Fig. 98.Conformable set of strata.

Congeners. Species which belong to the same genus.

Congeners. Species that are part of the same genus.

Conglomerate, or Puddingstone. Rounded water-worn fragments of rock or pebbles, cemented together by another mineral substance, which may be of a siliceous, calcareous, or argillaceous nature. Etym., con, together, glomero, to heap.

Conglomerate, or Puddingstone. Rounded, water-smoothed pieces of rock or pebbles, held together by another mineral substance, which could be siliceous, calcareous, or argillaceous in nature. Etym., con, together, glomero, to pile up.

Coniferæ. An order of plants, all of which have disks in their wood fibres, by which they are recognized in a fossil state. Their ovules are naked (see Gymnogens). Most of the northern kinds bear the seeds in cones; but the yew does not, nor do a host of tropical and south temperate species. Etym., conus, a cone, and fero, to bear.

Conifers. An order of plants that all have disks in their wood fibers, which helps identify them in fossil form. Their ovules are exposed (see Gymnogens). Most northern species produce seeds in cones; however, the yew does not, nor do many tropical and southern temperate species. Etym., conus, meaning cone, and fero, meaning to bear.

Cosmogony, Cosmology. Words synonymous in meaning, applied to speculations respecting the first origin or mode of creation of the earth. Etym., κοσμος, kosmos, the world, and γονη, gonee, generation, or λογος, logos, discourse.

Cosmology, Cosmology. These words are similar in meaning and refer to theories about the initial origin or method of the earth's creation. Etym., κοσμος, kosmos, meaning the world, and γονη, gonee, meaning generation, or λογος, logos, meaning discourse.

Crag. A provincial name in Norfolk and Suffolk for certain tertiary deposits usually composed of sand with shells, belonging to the Older Pliocene period.

Cliff. A local term in Norfolk and Suffolk for certain tertiary deposits that are typically made up of sand with shells, dating back to the Older Pliocene period.

Crater. The circular cavity at the summit of a volcano, from which the volcanic matter is ejected. Etym., crater, a great cup or bowl.

Crater. The circular opening at the top of a volcano where volcanic material is thrown out. Etym., crater, a large cup or bowl.

Cretaceous. Belonging to chalk. Etym., creta, chalk.

Cretaceous. Related to chalk. Etym., creta, chalk.

Crop Out. A miner's or mineral surveyor's term, to express the rising up or exposure at the surface of a stratum or series of strata.

Cut Out. A term used by miners or mineral surveyors to describe when a layer of rock or a series of layers is pushed up to the surface.

Crust of the Earth. See "Earth's crust."

Earth's crust. See "Earth's crust."

Crustaceous. Animals having a shelly coating or crust which they cast periodically. Crabs, shrimps, and lobsters are examples.

Crustacean. Animals with a shell or crust that they shed periodically. Crabs, shrimp, and lobsters are examples.

Cryptogamic. Asexual, flowerless, or Acotyledonous plants; a term applied to half the vegetable kingdom in contradistinction to Phænogamic, sexual, or flowering plants. It includes Fungi, Sea-weeds, Lichens, Mosses, Ferns, &c., which have no obvious flowers, and no cotyledons (seed-lobes) to their spores or seeds. Etym., κρυπτος, cruptos, concealed, and γαμος, gamos, marriage.

Fungal. Asexual, flowerless, or Acotyledonous plants; a term used for about half of the plant kingdom, in contrast to Phænogamic, sexual, or flowering plants. This includes Fungi, Seaweeds, Lichens, Mosses, Ferns, etc., which do not have obvious flowers and lack cotyledons (seed lobes) in their spores or seeds. Etym., κρυπτος, cruptos, concealed, and γαμος, gamos, marriage.

Crystals. Simple minerals are frequently found in regular forms, with facets like the drops of cut glass of chandeliers. Quartz being often met with in rocks in such forms, and beautifully transparent like ice, was called rock-crystal, κρυσταλλος, crystallos, being Greek for ice. Hence the regular forms of other minerals are called crystals, whether they be clear or opake.

Crystals. Simple minerals are often found in regular shapes, with faces like the cut glass pieces on chandeliers. Quartz is commonly found in rocks in such shapes and is beautifully clear like ice, which is why it’s called rock-crystal,κρυσταλλος, crystallos, the Greek word for ice. As a result, the regular forms of other minerals are referred to as crystals, regardless of whether they are clear or opaque.

Crystallized. A mineral which is found in regular forms or crystals is said to be crystallized.

Crystallized. A mineral that occurs in consistent shapes or crystals is described as crystallized.

Crystalline. The internal texture which regular crystals exhibit when broken, or a confused assemblage of ill-defined crystals. Loaf-sugar and statuary-marble have a crystalline texture. Sugar-candy and calcareous spar are crystallized.

Crystal clear. The internal texture that typical crystals show when they break, or a disorganized collection of poorly defined crystals. Loaf sugar and statuary marble have a crystalline texture. Sugar candy and calcareous spar are crystallized.

Cupriferous. Copper-bearing. Etym., cuprum, copper, and fero, to bear.

Copper-bearing.

Cycadeæ. A small and very anomalous order of flowering plants, chiefly found in Mexico, the East Indian Islands, South Africa, and Australia. They are Gymnogens as to ovules, and neither Exogens nor Endogens in the wood of their short, simple, or branched trunks, and they have dicotyledonous seeds. The leaves are pinnated (like those of cocoa-nut palms), and when young are rolled inwards as in Ferns. The wood fibres are curiously perforated, and marked, by which they are recognized in a fossil state as well as by the trunk and foliage, and the cones, which contain the male flowers. The term is derived from κυκας, cycas, a name applied by the ancient Greek naturalist Threophrastus to a palm.

Cycads. This is a small and quite unusual group of flowering plants, mainly found in Mexico, the East Indies, South Africa, and Australia. They are Gymnogens regarding their ovules, and their wood isn’t classified as either Exogens or Endogens in their short, simple, or branched trunks. They have seeds that are dicotyledonous. Their leaves are pinnate (like those of coconut palms), and when they are young, they roll inward similar to ferns. The wood fibers are interestingly perforated and marked, which helps identify them in fossil form as well as by their trunks, foliage, and cones, which contain the male flowers. The name comes from κυκας, cycas, a term used by the ancient Greek naturalist Theophrastus to refer to a palm.

Cyperaceæ. A tribe of plants answering to the English sedges; they are distinguished from grasses by their stems being solid, and generally triangular, instead of being hollow and round. Together with Gramineæ, they constitute what writers on botanical geography often call glumaceæ.

Cyperaceae. A group of plants similar to English sedges; they are different from grasses because their stems are solid and usually triangular, rather than hollow and round. Along with Gramineæ, they make up what botanical geography writers often refer to as glumaceæ.

Debacle. A great rush of waters, which, breaking down all opposing barriers, carries forward the broken fragments of rocks, and spreads them in its course. Etym., débacler, French, to unbar, to break up as a river does at the cessation of a long-continued frost.

Fail. A massive surge of water that overwhelms all obstacles, pushing along shattered pieces of rock and dispersing them as it flows. Etym., débacler, French, to unblock, to break apart like a river does when a prolonged freeze ends.

Delta. When a great river, before it enters the sea, divides into separate streams, they often diverge and form two sides of a triangle, the sea being the base. The land included by the three lines, and which is invariably alluvial, was first called, in the case of the Nile a delta, from its resemblance to the letter of the Greek 804 alphabet which goes by that name Δ. Geologists apply the term to alluvial land formed by a river at its mouth, without reference to its precise shape.

Delta. When a large river splits into different streams before it flows into the sea, those streams often spread out, creating two sides of a triangle, with the sea as the base. The land enclosed by these three lines, which is always made up of sediment, was first referred to as a delta in the case of the Nile, because it resembles the Greek letter 804 Δ. Geologists now use the term to describe any alluvial land formed by a river at its mouth, regardless of its specific shape.

Denudation. The carrying away by the action of running water of a portion of the solid materials of the land, by which inferior rocks are laid bare. Etym., denudo, to lay bare.

Erosion. The process of running water removing some of the solid materials from the land, exposing underlying rocks. Etym., denudo, to lay bare.

Deoxidized, Deoxidated. Deprived of oxygen. Disunited from oxygen.

Deoxidized, Deoxidized. Lacking oxygen. Separated from oxygen.

Desiccation. The art of drying up. Etym., desicco, to dry up.

Drying out. The process of drying out. Etym., desicco, to dry out.

Detritus. Matter worn or rubbed off from rocks. Etym., de, from, and tero, to rub.

Debris. Material worn or eroded from rocks. Etym., de, from, and tero, to rub.

Dicotyledonous. A grand division of the vegetable kingdom, founded on the plant having two cotyledons, or seed-lobes. Etym., δις, dis, double, and κοτυληδον, cotyledon.

Dicot. A major category in the plant kingdom, based on the presence of two cotyledons, or seed-lobes. Etym., δις, dis, double, and κοτυληδον, cotyledon.

Dikes. When a mass of the unstratified or igneous rocks, such as granite, trap, and lava, appears as if injected into a rent in the stratified rocks, cutting across the strata, it forms a dike. They are sometimes seen running along the ground, and projecting, like a wall, from the softer strata on both sides of them having wasted away; whence they were first called in the north of England and in Scotland dikes, a provincial name for wall. It is not easy to draw the line between dikes and veins. The former are generally of larger dimensions, and have their sides parallel for considerable distances; while veins have generally many ramifications, and these often thin away into slender threads.

Levees. When a mass of unstratified or igneous rocks, like granite, trap, and lava, looks like it's been pushed into a crack in the layered rocks, cutting across the layers, it forms a dike. Sometimes, they can be seen extending along the ground and jutting out like a wall from the softer layers on both sides that have eroded away; that's why they were originally called dikes in northern England and Scotland, as it is a local term for wall. It's not easy to distinguish between dikes and veins. Dikes are usually larger and have parallel sides for longer stretches, while veins often branch out and thin down into narrow threads.

Diluvium. Those accumulations of gravel and loose materials, which, by some geologists, are said to have been produced by the action of a diluvian wave or deluge sweeping over the surface of the earth. Etym., diluvium, deluge.

Diluvium. These piles of gravel and loose materials, which some geologists believe were created by the force of a flood or deluge that swept across the earth's surface. Etym., diluvium, deluge.

Dip. When a stratum does not lie horizontally, but is inclined, it is said to dip towards some point of the compass, and the angle it makes with the horizon is called the angle of dip or inclination.

Dip. When a layer isn’t flat but is tilted, it’s described as dipping toward a specific point on the compass, and the angle it forms with the horizontal plane is known as the angle of dip or inclination.

Diptera. An order of insects, comprising those which have only two wings. Etym., δις, dis, double, and πτερον, pteron, wing.

Flies. An order of insects that have just two wings. Etym., δις, dis, double, and πτερον, pteron, wing.

Dolerite. One of the varieties of the Trap-rocks, composed of augite and felspar.

Dolerite. A type of trap rock made up of augite and feldspar.

Dolomite. A crystalline limestone, containing magnesia as a constituent part. Named after the French geologist Dolomieu.

Dolomite A type of crystalline limestone that includes magnesium as a part of its composition. It’s named after the French geologist Dolomieu.

Dunes. Low hills of blown sand that skirt the shores of Holland, England, Spain, and other countries.

Sand dunes. Low hills of sand blown by the wind that line the shores of Holland, England, Spain, and other countries.

Earth's Crust. Such superficial parts of our planet as are accessible to human observation.

Earth's Surface. The outer layers of our planet that we can easily see and explore.

Eopyrosis. A Greek term for a destruction by fire.

Heartburn. A Greek term for destruction by fire.

Elytra. The wing-sheaths, or upper crustaceous membranes, which form the superior wings in the tribe of beetles. They cover the body, and protect the true membranous wing. Etym., ελυτρον, elytron, a sheath.

Elytra. The hard outer wings, or protective membranes, that make up the top wings in the beetle family. They cover the body and shield the actual membranous wings. Etym., ελυτρον, elytron, a sheath.

Endogens. A class of flowering plants, whose stems present no distinction of wood, pith, and bark. The wood is disposed in bundles, placed nearer the axis than those of the previous year, as in palm trunks. This class answers to the Monocotyledones of Jussieu. Etym., ενδον, endon, within, and γενεσις, genesis, increase.

Endogenous. A group of flowering plants whose stems do not have a clear separation of wood, pith, and bark. The wood is arranged in bundles that are located closer to the center than those from the previous year, similar to palm trunks. This group corresponds to the Monocotyledones classification by Jussieu. Etym., ενδον, endon, meaning within, and γενεσις, genesis, meaning increase.

Entomostraca. Cuvier's second section of Crustacea; so called from their relationship to insects. Etym., εντομα, entoma, insects.

Entomostracans. Cuvier's second section of Crustacea; named for their connection to insects. Etym., εντομα, entoma, insects.

Eocene. A name given to the lowest division of the tertiary strata, containing an extremely small percentage of living species amongst its fossil shells, which indicate the first commencement or dawn of the existing state of the animate creation. Etym., ηως, eos, aurora or the dawn, and καινος, kainos, recent.

Eocene epoch. This term refers to the earliest part of the tertiary strata, featuring a very small percentage of living species among its fossil shells, which signify the initial beginning or dawn of the current state of living creatures. Etym., ηως, eos, aurora or the dawn, and καινος, kainos, recent.

Escarpment. The abrupt face of a ridge of high land. Etym., escarper, French, to cut steep.

Escarpment. The steep face of a high ridge. Etym., escarper, French, to cut steep.

Estuaries. Inlets of the land, which are entered both by rivers and the tides of the sea. Thus we have the estuaries of the Thames, Severn, Tay, &c. Etym., æstus, the tide.

Estuaries. Openings in the land that are formed by both rivers and ocean tides. This includes the estuaries of the Thames, Severn, Tay, etc. Etym., æstus, meaning tide.

Exogens. A class of flowering plants whose stems have bark, wood, and pith. The bark is increased by layers deposited within the previously formed layers and the wood of layers or rings placed outside of those of the previous year. This class answers to the Dicotyledones of Jussieu, and includes all common English 805 trees except pines, &c. (See Gymnogens.) Etym., εξο, exo, outside, γενεσις, genesis, increase.

Exogenous factors. A group of flowering plants whose stems have bark, wood, and pith. The bark grows by adding layers that are deposited within the previously formed layers, and the wood consists of layers or rings added outside of those from the previous year. This group corresponds to the Dicotyledones of Jussieu and includes all common English805 trees except for pines, etc. (See Gymnogens.) Etym., εξο, exo, outside, γενεσις, genesis, increase.

Experimentum Crucis. A decisive experiment, so called, because, like a cross or direction-post, it directs men to true knowledge; or, as some explain it, because it is a kind of torture whereby the nature of the thing is extorted, as it were, by violence.

Critical Experiment. A crucial experiment, as it’s called, because it serves as a guide to genuine knowledge, similar to a crossroad or signpost; or, as some interpret it, because it’s a method of extracting the true nature of a thing, almost like a form of torture.

Exuviæ. Properly speaking, the transient parts of certain animals which they put off or lay down to assume new ones, as serpents and caterpillars shift their skins; but in geology it refers not only to the cast-off coverings of animals, but to fossil shells and other remains which animals have left in the strata of the earth. Etym., exuere, to put off or divest.

Exuviae. Technically, this refers to the temporary parts of certain animals that they shed or discard to grow new ones, like how snakes and caterpillars shed their skin; however, in geology, it pertains not only to these discarded coverings but also to fossil shells and other remnants that animals have left in the layers of the earth. Etym., exuere, to shed or remove.

Faluns. A French provincial name for some tertiary strata abounding in shells in Touraine, which resemble in lithological characters the "Crag" of Norfolk and Suffolk.

Faluns. A French regional term for certain sedimentary layers filled with shells in Touraine, which have similar geological features to the "Crag" found in Norfolk and Suffolk.

Fault, in the language of miners, is the sudden interruption of the continuity of strata in the same plane, accompanied Fig. 99.Fault. by a crack or fissure, varying in width from a mere line to several feet, which is generally filled with broken stone, clay, &c. The strata, a, b, c, &c., must at one time have been continuous; but a fracture having taken place at the fault F, either by the upheaving of the portion A, or the sinking of the portion B, the strata were so displaced that the bed a in B is many feet lower than the same bed a in the portion A.

Mistake in mining terms refers to the sudden break in the continuity of rock layers in the same plane, which is accompanied Fig. 99.Fault. by a crack or fissure that can range in width from a thin line to several feet. This crack is usually filled with broken rock, clay, etc. The layers, a, b, c, etc., must have once been continuous; however, a fracture at the fault F caused either the uplift of section A or the subsidence of section B, resulting in the layers being shifted so that the bed a in B is many feet lower than the same bed a in section A.

Fauna. The various kinds of animals peculiar to a country constitute its Fauna, as the various kinds of plants constitute its Flora. The term is derived from the Fauni, or rural deities, in Roman Mythology.

Wildlife. The different types of animals native to a country make up its Wildlife, just like the different types of plants make up its Plants. The term comes from the Fauni, which are rural gods in Roman mythology.

Felspar. A simple mineral, which, next to quartz, constitutes the chief material of rocks. The white angular portions in granite are felspar. This mineral always contains some alkali in its composition. In common felspar the alkali is potash; in another variety, called Albite or Cleavlandite, it is soda. Glassy felspar is a term applied when the crystals have a considerable degree of transparency. Compact felspar is a name of more vague signification. The substance so called appears to contain both potash and soda.

Feldspar. A simple mineral that, alongside quartz, makes up the main material of rocks. The white angular pieces in granite are feldspar. This mineral always has some alkali in its composition. In common feldspar, the alkali is potash; in another type called Albite or Cleavlandite, it is soda. The term glassy feldspar is used when the crystals are fairly transparent. Compact feldspar refers to a substance that seems to contain both potash and soda.

Felspathic. Of or belonging to felspar.

Felspathic. Related to feldspar.

Ferruginous. Any thing containing iron. Etym., ferrum, iron.

Ferruginous. Anything containing iron. Etym., ferrum, iron.

Fissile, easily cleft, dividing readily into an indefinite number of parallel laminæ, like slates.

Fissionable, easily split, dividing easily into countless parallel layers, like slates.

Floetz Rocks. A German term applied to the secondary strata by the geologists of that country, because these rocks were supposed to occur most frequently in flat horizontal beds. Etym., flotz, a layer or stratum.

Floetz Rocks. A German term used by geologists in that country to refer to secondary strata, as these rocks were thought to appear most often in flat, horizontal layers. Etym., flotz, a layer or stratum.

Flora. The various kinds of trees and plants found in any country constitute the Flora of that country in the language of botanists.

Plants. The different types of trees and plants found in any country make up the Plants of that country in botanical terms.

Fluviatile. Belonging to a river. Etym., fluvius, a river.

River-related. Related to a river. Etym., fluvius, a river.

Foraminifera. A name given by D'Orbigny to a family of microscopic shells. Their different chambers are united by a small perforation or foramen. Recent observation has shown that some at least are not Cephalopoda, as D'Orbigny supposed.

Forams. A term coined by D'Orbigny for a group of tiny shells. Their various chambers are connected by a small opening or foramen. Recent observations have indicated that at least some of them are not Cephalopoda, contrary to D'Orbigny's belief.

Formation. A group, whether of alluvial deposits, sedimentary strata, or igneous rocks, referred to a common origin or period.

Setup. A group, whether made up of alluvial deposits, sedimentary layers, or igneous rocks, that shares a common origin or time period.

Fossil. All minerals were once called fossils, but geologists now use the word only to express the remains of animals and plants found buried in the earth. Etym., fossilis, any thing that may be dug out of the earth.

Fossil. In the past, all minerals were referred to as fossils, but now geologists only use the term to refer to the remains of animals and plants that are found buried in the ground. Etym., fossilis, anything that can be dug out of the earth.

Fossiliferous. Containing organic remains.

Fossiliferous. Contains organic remains.

Galena. A metallic ore, a compound of lead and sulphur. It has often the appearance of highly polished lead. Etym., γαλεω, galeo, to shine.

Galena. A metallic ore, made up of lead and sulfur. It often looks like highly polished lead. Etym., γαλεω, galeo, to shine.

Garnet. A simple mineral, generally of a deep red color, crystallized; most commonly met with in mica slate, but also in granite and other igneous rocks.

Garnet gemstone. A straightforward mineral, usually a deep red color, crystallized; typically found in mica schist, but also in granite and other volcanic rocks.

Gasteropods. A division of the Testacea, in which, as in the limpet, the foot is attached to the body. Etym., γαστηρ, gaster, belly, and ποδα, poda, feet.

Snails and slugs. A group of the Testacea, where, like in the limpet, the foot is connected to the body. Etym., γαστηρ, gaster, belly, and ποδα, poda, feet.

Gault. A provincial name in the east of England for a series of beds of clay and marl, the geological position of which is between the Upper and Lower Greensand.

Gault. A regional name in eastern England for a set of clay and marl layers, which are found between the Upper and Lower Greensand.

Gavial. A kind of crocodile found in India.

Gharial. A type of crocodile found in India.

Gem, or Gemmule, from the Latin gemma, a bud. The term, applied to zoophytes, means a young animal not confined within an envelope or egg.

Gemstone, or Gemmule, from the Latin gemma, meaning a bud. The term, used for zoophytes, refers to a young animal that isn't enclosed within an envelope or egg.

Geology, Geognosy. Both mean the same thing; but with an unnecessary degree of refinement in terms, it has been proposed to call our description of the structure of the earth geognosy (Etym., γεα, gea, earth, and γινωσcω, ginosco, to know), and our theoretical speculations as to its formation geology (Etym., γεα, and λογος, logos, a discourse).

Geology, Geology. Both refer to the same concept; however, with an unnecessary level of complexity in terminology, it has been suggested to label our description of the earth’s structure as geognosy (Etym., γεα, gea, meaning earth, and γινωσcω, ginosco, meaning to know), and our theoretical ideas about its formation as geology (Etym., γεα, and λογος, logos, meaning discourse).

Glacier. Vast accumulations of ice and hardened snow in the Alps and other lofty mountains. Etym., glace, French for ice.

Glacier. Huge masses of ice and compacted snow found in the Alps and other tall mountains. Etym., glace, French for ice.

Glacis. A term borrowed from the language of fortification, where it means an easy insensible slope or declivity, less steep than a talus, which see.

Glacis. A term taken from the field of fortification, where it refers to a gentle, gradual slope that is less steep than a talus, which you can look up.

Gneiss. A stratified primary rock, composed of the same materials as granite, but having usually a larger proportion of mica and a laminated texture. The word is a German miner's term.

Gneiss. A layered primary rock made up of the same materials as granite, but typically containing more mica and having a banded texture. The term comes from a German mining vocabulary.

Gramineæ. The order of plants to which grasses belong. Etym., gramen, grass.

Grasses. The group of plants that includes grasses. Etym., gramen, grass.

Granite. An unstratified or igneous rock, generally found inferior to or associated with the oldest of the stratified rocks, and sometimes penetrating them in the form of dikes and veins. It is usually composed of three simple minerals, felspar, quartz, and mica, and derives its name from having a coarse granular structure; granum, Latin for grain. Waterloo bridge, and the paving-stones in the carriage-way of the London streets, afford good examples of the most common varieties of granite.

Granite. A type of unlayered or igneous rock, typically found beneath or alongside the oldest layered rocks and sometimes cutting through them as dikes and veins. It usually consists of three basic minerals: feldspar, quartz, and mica, and gets its name from its coarse granular texture; granum means grain in Latin. Waterloo Bridge and the paving stones in the carriageway of London streets provide good examples of the most common types of granite.

Greensand. Beds of sand, sandstone, limestone, belonging to the Cretaceous Period. The name is given to these beds because they often, but not always, contain an abundance of green earth or chlorite scattered through the substance of the sandstone, limestone, &c.

Greensand. Layers of sand, sandstone, and limestone from the Cretaceous Period. These layers are called greensand because they often, but not always, have a lot of green earth or chlorite mixed in with the sandstone, limestone, etc.

Greenstone. A variety of trap, composed of hornblende and felspar.

Greenstone. A type of rock formed from hornblende and feldspar.

Greywacké. Grauwacke, a German name, generally adopted by geologists for some of the most ancient fossiliferous strata. The rock is very often of a gray color; hence the name, grau, being German for gray, and wacke, being a provincial miner's term.

Greywacke. Grauwacke, a German term, is commonly used by geologists to refer to some of the oldest fossil-rich layers. The rock is typically gray in color, which is reflected in the name, as grau means gray in German, and wacke is a local miner's term.

Grit. A provincial name for a coarse-grained sandstone.

Resilience. A regional term for a rough-textured sandstone.

Gymnospermous. Etym., γυμνος, gymnos, naked, and σπερμα, sperma, a seed. (See Gymnogens.)

Gymnosperm. Etym., γυμνος, gymnos, naked, and σπερμα, sperma, a seed. (See Gymnogens.)

Gymnogens. A class of flowering plants, in which the ovules are not inclosed in an ovary. They are also called gymnosperms, the seeds in like manner not being inclosed in a pericarp. It includes all Coniferæ, as pine, fir, juniper, cypress, yew, cedar, &c., and Cycadeæ. All are Dicotyledonous (a few have many cotyledons), and all Exogenous, except Cycas, the growth of which is anomalous. The term is applied in contradistinction to Angiosperms, which see. Etym., γυμνος, naked, and γενεσις, increase.

Gymnosperms. This is a class of flowering plants where the ovules are not enclosed in an ovary. They’re also known as gymnosperms, as their seeds likewise aren't enclosed in a pericarp. This class includes all Coniferæ such as pine, fir, juniper, cypress, yew, cedar, etc., and Cycadeæ. All are Dicotyledonous (though a few have many cotyledons), and all are Exogenous, except for Cycas, which has a unique growth pattern. The term is used in contrast to Angiosperms, which you can refer to for more information. Etym., γυμνος, meaning naked, and γενεσις, meaning increase.

Gypsum. A mineral composed of lime and sulphuric acid, hence called also sulphate of lime. Plaster and stucco are obtained by exposing gypsum to a strong heat. It is found so abundantly near Paris, that plaster of Paris is a common term in this country for the white powder of which casts are made. The term is used by Pliny for a stone used for the same purposes by the ancients. The derivation is unknown.

Gypsum. A mineral made up of lime and sulfuric acid, which is also known as sulfate of lime. Plaster and stucco are produced by heating gypsum to a high temperature. It is so plentiful near Paris that "plaster of Paris" has become a common term in this country for the white powder used to make casts. Pliny used the term for a stone that served the same purposes for the ancients. The origin of the term is unknown.

Gypseous, of or belonging to gypsum.

Gypsum-related

Gyrogonites. Bodies found in freshwater deposits, originally supposed to be microscopic shells, but subsequently discovered to be seed-vessels of freshwater plants 807 of the genus Chara. See above p. 742. Etym., γυρος, gyros, curved, and γονος, gonos, seed, on account of their external structure.

Gyrogonites. Bodies found in freshwater deposits, originally thought to be microscopic shells, but later found to be seed vessels of freshwater plants 807 of the genus Chara. See above p. 742. Etym., γυρος, gyros, curved, and γονος, gonos, seed, based on their external structure.

Hemiptera. An order of insects, so called from a peculiarity in their wings, the superior being coriaceous at the base and membranous at the apex, ἡμισυ, hemisu, half, and πτερον, pteron, wing.

Hemiptera. A group of insects named for a special feature in their wings, where the front part is tough at the base and thin at the tip. The term comes from ἡμισυ, hemisu, meaning half, and πτερον, pteron, meaning wing.

Hornblende. A simple mineral of a dark green or black color, which enters largely into the composition of several varieties of the Trap-Rocks.

Hornblende. A basic mineral that is dark green or black, which makes up a significant part of several types of Trap-Rocks.

Hornstone. A siliceous mineral substance, sometimes approaching nearly to flint, or common quartz. It has a conchoidal fracture, and is infusible, which distinguishes it from compact felspar.

Hornstone. A silicate mineral that is sometimes very similar to flint or regular quartz. It has a conchoidal fracture and doesn't melt, which sets it apart from dense feldspar.

Humerus. The bone of the upper arm.

Humerus. The bone in the upper arm.

Hydrophytes. Plants which grow in water. Etym., ὑδωρ, hydor, water, and φυτον, phyton, plant.

Aquatic plants. Plants that grow in water. Etym., ὑδωρ, hydor, water, and φυτον, phyton, plant.

Hypogene Rocks. Those rocks which are nether-formed, or which have not assumed their present form and structure at the surface, such as granite, gneiss, &c. The term, which includes both the plutonic and metamorphic rocks, is substituted for primary, because some members of both these classes, such as granite and gneiss, are posterior to many secondary or fossiliferous rocks. Etym., ὑπο, hypo, under, and γινομαι, ginomai, to be formed or produced.

Hypogene rocks. These are rocks that are nether-formed, or that haven't taken on their current shape and structure at the surface, like granite, gneiss, etc. The term, which includes both plutonic and metamorphic rocks, is used instead of primary because some members of both classes, like granite and gneiss, came after many secondary or fossil-bearing rocks. Etym., ὑπο, hypo, meaning under, and γινομαι, ginomai, meaning to be formed or produced.

Iceberg. Great masses of ice, often the size of hills, which float in the polar and adjacent seas. Etym., ice, and berg, German for hill.

Iceberg. Large chunks of ice, often the size of hills, that float in polar and nearby seas. Etym., ice, and berg, German for hill.

Ichthyosaurus. A gigantic fossil marine reptile, allied in part of its structure to a fish. Etym., ιχθυς, ichthus, a fish, and σαυρα, saura, a lizard.

Ichthyosaurus. A massive fossil marine reptile, partially similar in structure to a fish. Etym., ιχθυς, ichthus, a fish, and σαυρα, saura, a lizard.

Igneous Rocks. All rocks, such as lava, trap, and granite, known or supposed to have been melted by volcanic heat.

Igneous Rocks. All rocks, like lava, trap rock, and granite, are known or believed to be formed by volcanic heat.

Incandescent. White hot—having a more intense degree of heat than red heat.

Bright. White hot—having a higher level of heat than red heat.

Induction. A consequence, inference, or general principle drawn from a number of particular facts or phenomena. The inductive philosophy, says Mr. Whewell, has been rightly described as a science which ascends from particular facts to general principles, and then descends again from these general principles to particular applications.

Introduction. A conclusion, deduction, or general rule derived from several specific facts or events. The inductive philosophy, according to Mr. Whewell, has been accurately described as a science that moves from specific facts to general principles and then returns from those general principles to specific applications.

Infusory Animalcules. Minute living creatures found in many infusions; and the term infusori has been given to all such animalcules, whether found in infusions or in stagnant water, vinegar, &c.

Infusory microorganisms. Tiny living organisms found in many infusions; the term infusori refers to all these organisms, whether they are found in infusions or in stagnant water, vinegar, etc.

Inspissated. Thickened. Etym., spissus, thick.

Thickened. Thickened. Etym., spissus, thick.

Invertebrated Animals. Animals which are not furnished with a back-bone. For a further explanation, see "Vertebrated Animals."

Invertebrates. Animals that do not have a backbone. For more information, see "Vertebrate Animals."

Isothermal. Such zones or divisions of the land, ocean, or atmosphere, which have an equal degree of mean annual warmth, are said to be isothermal, from ισος, isos, equal, and θερμη, therme, heat.

Constant temperature. Areas of land, ocean, or atmosphere that maintain the same average annual temperature are referred to as isothermal, derived from ισος, isos, meaning equal, and θερμη, therme, meaning heat.

Joints. Fissures or lines of parting in rocks, often at right angles to the planes of stratification. The partings which divide columnar basalt into prisms are joints.

Joints. Cracks or separations in rocks, usually at right angles to the layers of sediment. The separations that break columnar basalt into prisms are called joints.

Jura Limestone. The limestones belonging to the Oolite Group constitute the chief part of the mountains of Jura between France and Switzerland; and hence the geologists of the Continent have given the name to the group.

Jura Limestone. The limestones of the Oolite Group make up the main part of the Jura mountains between France and Switzerland, which is why geologists in Europe named the group after them.

Keuper. A German name for a member of the Upper New Red Sandstone.

Keuper sandstone. A German term for a type of Upper New Red Sandstone.

Kimmeridge Clay. A thick bed of clay, constituting a member of the Oolite Group. So called because it is found well developed at Kimmeridge, in the Isle of Purbeck, Dorsetshire.

Kimmeridge Formation. A thick layer of clay that is part of the Oolite Group. It's named after Kimmeridge, located in the Isle of Purbeck, Dorset.

Lacustrine. Belonging to a lake. Etym., lacus, a lake.

Lake-related. Related to a lake. Etym., lacus, a lake.

Lamantine. A living species of the herbivorous Cetacea or whale tribe which inhabits the mouth of rivers on the coasts of Africa and South America: the sea-cow.

Lamantin. A living species of the herbivorous Cetacea or whale family that lives at the mouths of rivers along the coasts of Africa and South America: the sea cow.

Lamelliferous. Having a structure consisting of thin plates or leaves like paper. Etym., lamella, the diminutive of lamina, plate, and fero, to bear.

Lamelliform. Having a structure made up of thin plates or layers like paper. Etym. From lamella, the diminutive of lamina, meaning plate, and fero, meaning to bear.

Laminæ. Latin for plates; used in geology for the smaller layers of which a stratum is frequently composed.

Laminae. Latin for plates; used in geology for the smaller layers that often make up a stratum.

Landslip. A portion of land that has slid down in consequence of disturbance by an earthquake, or from being undermined by water washing away the lower beds which supported it.

Landslide. A section of land that has collapsed due to disruption from an earthquake, or from being eroded by water that has washed away the lower layers supporting it.

Lapidification. Lapidifying process. Conversion into stone. Etym., lapis, stone, and fio, to make.

Lapidification. The process of turning into stone. Etym., lapis, stone, and fio, to make.

Lapilli. Small volcanic cinders. Lapillus, a little stone.

Lapilli. Small volcanic cinders. Lapillus, a small stone.

Lava. The stone which flows in a melted state from a volcano.

Lava. The rock that flows in a molten state from a volcano.

Lepidodendron, a genus of fossil plants of the Coal Measures, intermediate in character between the Lycopodiums and coniferous plants.

Lepidodendron is a genus of fossil plants from the Coal Measures, having characteristics that lie between Lycopodiums and coniferous plants.

Leucite. A simple mineral found in volcanic rocks, crystallized, and of a white color. Etym., λευcος, leucos, white.

Leucite. A basic mineral found in volcanic rocks, crystallized, and white in color. Etym., λευκος, leucos, white.

Lias. A provincial name for an argillaceous limestone, characterized together with its associated beds by peculiar fossils, and forming a particular group of strata, interposed between the Oolite and the New Red Sandstone.

Lies. A regional term for a type of clay-rich limestone, recognized along with its accompanying layers by unique fossils, and making up a specific set of rock layers situated between the Oolite and the New Red Sandstone.

Ligniperdous. A term applied to insects which destroy wood. Etym., lignum, wood, and perdo, to destroy.

Ligniperdous. A term used for insects that damage wood. Etym., lignum, wood, and perdo, to destroy.

Lignite. Wood converted into a kind of coal. Etym., lignum, wood.

Lignite coal. Wood turned into a type of coal. Etym., lignum, wood.

Lithodomi. Molluscous animals which form holes in the solid rocks in which they lodge themselves. The holes are not perforated mechanically, but the rock appears to be dissolved. Etym., λιθος, lithos, stone, and δεμο, demo, to build.

Lithodomi. Mollusks that create holes in solid rocks where they reside. The holes aren't made by drilling; instead, the rock seems to be dissolved. Etym., λιθος, lithos, stone, and δεμο, demo, to build.

Lithogenous Polyps. Animals which form coral.

Lithogenous Polyps. Coral-forming animals.

Lithographic Stone. A slaty compact limestone, of a yellowish color and fine grain, used in lithography, which is the art of drawing upon and printing from stone Etym., λιθος, lithos, stone, and γραφο, grapho, to write.

Lithography stone. A hard, smooth limestone that is yellowish and has a fine grain, used in lithography, which is the method of drawing on and printing from stone Etym., λιθος, lithos, stone, and γραφο, grapho, to write.

Lithoidal. Having a stony structure.

Lithoidal. Having a rocky structure.

Lithological. A term expressing the stony structure or character of a mineral mass. We speak of the lithological character of a stratum as distinguished from its zoological character. Etym., λιθος, lithos, stone, and λογος, logos, discourse.

Rock type. A term that describes the rock-like structure or traits of a mineral mass. We refer to the lithological characteristics of a layer, distinguishing it from its biological characteristics. Etym., λιθος, lithos, stone, and λογος, logos, discourse.

Lithophagi. Molluscous animals which form holes in solid stones. See "Lithodomi." Etym., λιθος, lithos, stone, and φαγειν, phagein, to eat.

Rock-eaters. Mollusk animals that create holes in solid rocks. See "Lithodomi." Etym., λιθος, lithos, stone, and φαγειν, phagein, to eat.

Lithophites. The animals which form Stone-coral.

Lithophites. The animals that create stone coral.

Littoral. Belonging to the shore. Etym., littus, the shore.

Coastal. Related to the shore. Etym., littus, the shore.

Loam. A mixture of sand and clay.

Loamy soil. A blend of sand and clay.

Lophiodon. A genus of extinct quadrupeds, allied to the tapir, named from eminences on the teeth.

Lophiodon. A genus of extinct four-legged animals related to the tapir, named for the raised areas on their teeth.

Lycopodiaceæ. Plants of an inferior degree of organization to Coniferæ, some of which they very much resemble in foliage, but all recent species are infinitely smaller. Many of the fossil species are as gigantic as recent Coniferæ. Their mode of reproduction is analogous to that of ferns. In English they are called club-mosses, generally found in mountainous heaths in the north of England.

Lycopodiaceae. These plants are less complex than Coniferæ, and some look quite similar in their leaves, but all living species are much smaller. Many of the fossil species were as huge as modern Coniferæ. They reproduce like ferns. In English, they are known as club-mosses, typically found in hilly heathlands in northern England.

Lydian Stone. Flinty slate; a kind of quartz or flint, allied to Hornstone, but of a grayish black color.

Lydian Stone. A hard slate; a type of quartz or flint, related to Hornstone, but with a grayish-black color.

Macigno. In Italy this term has been applied to a siliceous sandstone sometimes containing calcareous grains, mica, &c.

Macigno. In Italy, this term refers to a siliceous sandstone that sometimes includes calcium-rich grains, mica, and so on.

Madrepore. A genus of corals, but generally applied to all the corals distinguished by superficial star-shaped cavities. There are several fossil species.

Coral. A type of coral, but usually used to refer to all corals that have star-shaped patterns on the surface. There are several fossil species.

Magnesian Limestone. An extensive series of beds, the geological position of which is immediately above the Coal Measures; so called, because the limestone, the principal member of the series, contains much of the earth magnesia as a constituent part.

Magnesium Limestone. A large set of layers, positioned right above the Coal Measures; it's named this way because the limestone, the main component of the series, has a lot of magnesium as a key ingredient.

Mammiferous. Mammifers. Animals which give suck to their young. To this class all the warm-blooded quadrupeds, and the Cetacea, or whales, belong. Etym., mamma, a breast, fero, to bear.

Mammals. Mammals. Animals that breastfeed their young. This group includes all warm-blooded four-legged animals and the Cetacea, or whales. Etym. mamma, a breast, fero, to bear.

Mammillary. A surface which is studded over with rounded projections. Etym., mammilla, a little breast or pap.

Mammary. A surface that is covered with rounded bumps. Etym., mammilla, a small breast or nipple.

Mammoth. An extinct species of the elephant (E. primigenius), of which the fossil bones are frequently met with in various countries. The name is of Tartar origin, and is used in Siberia for animals that burrow under ground.

Mammoth. An extinct species of elephant (E. primigenius) whose fossil bones are commonly found in different countries. The name comes from Tartar origins and is used in Siberia for animals that dig burrows underground.

Manati. One of the Cetacea, the sea-cow, or lamantine (Trichechus manatus, Lin.)

Manatee. One of the cetaceans, the sea cow, or manatee (Trichechus manatus, Lin.)

Marl. A mixture of clay and lime; usually soft, but sometimes hard, in which case it is called indurated marl.

Marlboro. A blend of clay and lime; typically soft, but sometimes hard, in which case it’s referred to as indurated marl.

Marsupial Animals. A tribe of quadrupeds having a sack or pouch under the belly, in which they carry their young. The kangaroo is a well-known example. Etym., marsupium, a purse.

Marsupial Animals. A group of four-legged animals that have a pouch on their belly where they carry their young. The kangaroo is a well-known example. Etym., marsupium, a purse.

Mastodon. A genus of fossil extinct quadrupeds allied to the elephants; so called from the form of the hind teeth or grinders, which have their surface covered with conical mammillary crests. Etym., μαστος, mastos, pap, and οδων, odon, tooth.

Mastodon. A genus of extinct four-legged mammals related to elephants; named for the shape of the back teeth or molars, which have surfaces covered with cone-shaped bumps. Etym., μαστος, mastos, breast, and οδων, odon, tooth.

Matrix. If a simple mineral or shell, in place of being detached, be still fixed in a portion of rock, it is said to be in its matrix. Matrix, womb.

Matrix. If a simple mineral or shell, instead of being separated, is still embedded in a piece of rock, it is said to be in its matrix. Matrix, womb.

Mechanical Origin, Rocks of. Rocks composed of sand, pebbles, or fragments, are so called to distinguish them from those of a uniform crystalline texture, which are of chemical origin.

Rocks of Mechanical Origin. Rocks made up of sand, pebbles, or fragments are called this to set them apart from those that have a consistent crystalline texture, which are formed by chemical processes.

Medusæ. A genus of marine radiated animals, without shells; so called, because their organs of motion spread out like the snaky hair of the fabulous Medusa.

Jellyfish. A group of marine animals with a radiated shape, lacking shells; named because their means of movement fan out like the snake-like hair of the mythical Medusa.

Megalosaurus. A fossil gigantic amphibious animal of the saurian or lizard and crocodile tribe. Etym., μεγαλη, megale, great, and σαυρα, saura, lizard.

Megalosaurus. A fossilized giant amphibious creature from the lizard and crocodile family. Etym., μεγάλη, megale, great, and σαύρα, saura, lizard.

Megatherium. A fossil extinct quadruped, resembling a gigantic sloth. Etym., μεγα, mega, great, and θηριον, therion, wild beast.

Megatherium. A fossilized extinct four-legged animal that looks like a huge sloth. Etym., μεγα, mega, great, and θηριον, therion, wild beast.

Melastoma. A genus of Melastomacea, an order of exotic plants of the evergreen tree and shrubby kinds. Etym., μελας, melas, black, and στομα, stoma, mouth; because the fruit of one of these species stains the lips.

Melastome. A genus of Melastome family, a group of unique plants that includes evergreen trees and shrubs. Etym., μελας, melas, meaning black, and στομα, stoma, meaning mouth; because the fruit of one of these species leaves a stain on the lips.

Mesotype. A simple mineral, white, and needle-shaped, one of the Zeolite family, frequently met with in the Trap-rocks.

Mesotype. A straightforward mineral that is white and shaped like needles, part of the Zeolite family, commonly found in trap rocks.

Metamorphic Rocks. A stratified division of hypogene rocks, highly crystalline, such as gneiss and mica-schist, and so named because they have been altered by plutonic action. Etym., μετα, meta, trans, and μορφη, morphe, form.

Metamorphic rocks. A layered category of deep-seated rocks, highly crystalline, like gneiss and mica-schist, and known as such because they have been changed by plutonic processes. Etym., μετα, meta, trans, and μορφη, morphe, form.

Mica. A simple mineral, having a shining silvery surface, and capable of being split into very thin elastic leaves or scales. It is often called talc in common life; but mineralogists apply the term talc to a different mineral. The brilliant scales in granite are mica. Etym., mico, to shine.

Mica. A basic mineral with a shiny silver surface that can be split into very thin, flexible sheets or scales. It's often referred to as talc in everyday conversation, but mineralogists use the term talc for a different mineral. The shiny scales found in granite are mica. Etym., mico, meaning to shine.

Mica-slate, Mica-Schist, Micaceous Schistus. One of the metamorphic or crystalline stratified rocks of the hypogene class, which is characterized by being composed of a large proportion of mica united with quartz.

Mica slate, mica schist, micaceous schist. This is one of the metamorphic or crystalline sedimentary rocks from the hypogene category, known for its high mica content mixed with quartz.

Miocene. A division of tertiary strata intervening between the Eocene and Pliocene formations; so called, because a minority of its fossil shells are referable to living species. Etym., μειων, meion, less, and καινος, kainos, recent.

Miocene epoch. A division of tertiary rock layers that exists between the Eocene and Pliocene formations; named so because a small number of its fossil shells can be linked to species that are still alive today. Etym., μειων, meion, less, and καινος, kainos, recent.

Molasse. A provincial name for a soft green sandstone, associated with marl and conglomerates, belonging to the Miocene Tertiary Period, extensively developed in the lower country of Switzerland. Etym., French, molle, soft.

Molasses. A regional term for a soft green sandstone, related to marl and conglomerates, from the Miocene Tertiary Period, found abundantly in the lowlands of Switzerland. Etym., French, molle, soft.

Mollusca, Molluscous Animals. Animals, such as shell-fish, which, being devoid of bones, have soft bodies. Etym., mollis, soft.

Mollusks, Soft-bodied Animals. Animals like shellfish that, lacking bones, have soft bodies. Etym., mollis, soft.

Monad. The smallest of visible animalcules, spoken of by Buffon and his followers as constituting the elementary molecules of organic beings.

Monad. The tiniest visible microorganisms, referred to by Buffon and his followers as the basic building blocks of living organisms.

Monitor. An animal of the saurian or lizard tribe, species of which are found in both the fossil and recent state.

Screen. A type of lizard, with species that exist both as fossils and in modern times.

Monocotyledonous. A grand division of the vegetable kingdom (including palms, grasses, Lilaceæ, &c.), founded on the plant having only one cotyledon, or seed-lobe. Etym., μονος, monos, single.

Monocot. A major division of the plant kingdom (including palms, grasses, Lilaceæ, etc.), based on the plant having just one cotyledon, or seed-lobe. Etym., μονος, monos, single.

Moraine, a Swiss term for the débris of rocks brought into valleys by glaciers. See p. 228.

Moraine, a Swiss term for the debris of rocks carried into valleys by glaciers. See p. 228.

Moschus. A quadruped resembling the chamois or mountain goat, from which the perfume musk is obtained.

Musk. A four-legged animal similar to the chamois or mountain goat, from which the fragrance musk is derived.

Mountain Limestone, or Carboniferous Limestone. A series of limestone strata of marine origin, usually forming the lowest member of the Coal Measures.

Limestone, or Carboniferous Limestone. A set of limestone layers from marine sources, typically making up the lowest part of the Coal Measures.

Moya. A term applied in South America to mud poured out from volcanoes during eruptions.

Moya. A term used in South America for the mud that flows from volcanoes during eruptions.

Multilocular. Many-chambered; a term applied to those shells which, like the nautilus, ammonite, and others, are divided into many compartments. Etym., multus, many, and loculus, a partition.

Multicompartment. Many-chambered; a term used for shells that, like the nautilus, ammonite, and others, are divided into multiple compartments. Etym. multus, many, and loculus, a partition.

Muriate of Soda. The scientific name for common culinary salt, because it is composed of muriatic acid and the alkali soda.

Sodium chloride. The scientific name for regular table salt, as it consists of muriatic acid and the alkali soda.

Musaceæ. A family of tropical monocotyledonous plants, including the banana and plantains.

Musaceae. A family of tropical monocot plants, including bananas and plantains.

Muschelkalk. A limestone, belonging to the Upper New Red Sandstone group. Its position is between the Magnesian Limestone and the Lias. This formation has not yet been found in England, and the German name is adopted by English geologists. The word means shell limestone. Etym., muschel, shell, and kalkstein, limestone.

Muschelkalk. A limestone that belongs to the Upper New Red Sandstone group. Its position is between the Magnesian Limestone and the Lias. This formation has not yet been found in England, and English geologists have adopted the German name. The word means shell limestone. Etym., muschel, shell, and kalkstein, limestone.

Naphtha. A very thin, volatile, inflammable, and fluid mineral substance, of which there are springs in many countries, particularly in volcanic districts.

Naphtha. A very light, volatile, flammable, and liquid mineral substance, found in natural springs in many countries, especially in volcanic areas.

Nenuphar. A yellow water-lily. P. 618.

Nenuphar. A yellow water lily. P. 618.

New Red Sandstone. A formation so named, because it consists chiefly of sandy and argillaceous strata, the predominant color of which is brick-red, but containing portions which are of a greenish-gray. These occur often in spots and stripes, so that the series has sometimes been called the variegated sandstone. This formation is divided into the Upper New Red in which the Muschelkalk is included, and the Lower New Red, of which the Magnesian Limestone is a member.

New Red Sandstone. This formation is named because it mainly consists of sandy and clay-rich layers, with a brick-red color being the most common, though some areas have a greenish-gray hue. These colors often appear in patches and stripes, leading to the series sometimes being referred to as variegated sandstone. This formation is split into the Upper New Red, which includes the Muschelkalk, and the Lower New Red, of which the Magnesian Limestone is a part.

Nodule. A rounded irregular-shaped lump or mass. Etym., diminutive of nodus, knot.

Nodule. A rounded, irregular lump or mass. Etym., diminutive of nodus, knot.

Normal Groups. Groups of certain rocks taken as a rule or standard. Etym., norma, rule or pattern.

Standard Groups. Groups of specific rocks used as a standard or guideline. Etym., norma, rule or pattern.

Nucleus. A solid central piece, around which other matter is collected. The word is Latin for kernel.

Nucleus. A solid central part, around which other matter gathers. The word comes from Latin meaning kernel.

Nummulites. An extinct genus of the order of molluscous animals, called Cephalopoda, of a thin lenticular shape, internally divided into small chambers. Etym., nummus, Latin for money, and λιθος, lithos, stone, from its resemblance to a coin.

Nummulites. An extinct genus from the class of mollusk animals known as Cephalopoda, having a thin, lens-shaped structure divided internally into small chambers. Etym., nummus, Latin for money, and λιθος, lithos, meaning stone, because of its similarity to a coin.

Obsidian. A volcanic product, or species of lava, very like common green bottle glass, which is almost black in large masses, but semi-transparent in thin fragments. Pumice-stone is obsidian in a frothy state; produced, most probably, by water that was contained in or had access to the melted stone, and converted into steam. There are very often portions in masses of solid obsidian, which are partially converted into pumice.

Obsidian. It's a type of volcanic rock or lava that resembles regular green bottle glass, appearing almost black in large chunks but semi-transparent in thin pieces. Pumice is essentially obsidian in a bubbly form, likely created by water that was trapped in or able to reach the molten rock, turning into steam. Often, you can find sections in solid obsidian that have partially transformed into pumice.

Ochre. A yellow powder, a combination of some earth with oxide of iron.

Ochre. A yellow powder made from a mixture of clay and iron oxide.

Ogygian Deluge. A great inundation mentioned in fabulous history, supposed to have taken place in the reign of Ogyges in Attica, whose death is fixed in Blair's Chronological Tables in the year 1764 before Christ. See p. 341.

Ogygian Flood. A massive flood referenced in legendary history, believed to have occurred during the rule of Ogyges in Attica, whose death is recorded in Blair's Chronological Tables as happening in 1764 BC. See p. 341.

Old Red Sandstone. A formation immediately below the Carboniferous Group. The term Devonian has been recently proposed for strata of this age, because in Devonshire they are largely developed, and contain many organic remains.

Old Red Sandstone. A formation directly beneath the Carboniferous Group. The term Devonian has been recently suggested for layers of this age, as they are extensively developed in Devonshire and include many organic remains.

Oligoclase. A mineral of the felspar family.

Oligoclase. A type of mineral in the feldspar family.

Olivine. An olive-colored, semi-transparent, simple mineral, very often occurring in the form of grains and of crystals in basalt and lava.

Olivine gemstone. A semi-transparent mineral that is olive-colored, often found as grains and crystals in basalt and lava.

Oolite, Oolitic. A limestone; so named because it is composed of rounded particles like the roe or eggs of a fish. The name is also applied to a large group of strata, characterized by peculiar fossils, in which limestone of this texture occurs. Etym., ωον, oon, egg, and λιθος, lithos, stone.

Oolite, Oolitic. A type of limestone named for its rounded particles that resemble fish eggs. The term also refers to a large group of rock layers that contain these unique fossils and where this textured limestone is found. Etym., ωον, oon, egg, and λιθος, lithos, stone.

Opalized Wood. Wood petrified by siliceous earth, and acquiring a structure similar to the simple mineral called opal.

Opalized wood. Wood that has been turned to stone by silica-rich earth, taking on a structure similar to the mineral known as opal.

Ophidious Reptiles. Vertebrated animals, such as snakes and serpents. Etym., οφις, ophis, a serpent.

Snake Species. Vertebrate animals, like snakes and serpents. Etym., οφις, ophis, a serpent.

Organic Remains. The remains of animals and plants (organized bodies) found in a fossil state.

Organic Remains. The remains of animals and plants (organized bodies) discovered in a fossilized state.

Orthocerata or Ohthoceræ. An extinct genus of the order of molluscous animals, called Cephalopoda, that inhabited a long-chambered conical shell, like a straight horn. Etym., ορθος, orthos, straight, and κερας, ceras, horn.

Orthocerata or Ohthoceræ. An extinct genus of mollusks from the order Cephalopoda, which lived in a long, conical shell that resembled a straight horn. Etym., ορθος, orthos, straight, and κερας, ceras, horn.

Osseous Breccia. The cemented mass of fragments of bones of extinct animals found in caverns and fissures. Osseous is a Latin adjective, signifying bony.

Bone Fragment Rock. The solid mass of broken fragments of bones from extinct animals found in caves and cracks. Osseous is a Latin adjective that means bony.

Osteology. That division of anatomy which treats of the bones; from οστεον, osteon, bone, and λογος, logos, a discourse.

Bone anatomy. This branch of anatomy focuses on bones; from οστεον, osteon, meaning bone, and λογος, logos, meaning discourse.

Outliers. When a portion of a stratum occurs at some distance, detached from the general mass of the formation to which it belongs, some practical mineral surveyors call it an outlier, and the term is adopted in geological language.

Outliers. When a part of a layer is found away from the main body of the formation it belongs to, some practical mineral surveyors refer to it as an outlier, and this term is used in geological terminology.

Ovate. The shape of an egg. Etym., ovum, egg.

Oval. The shape of an egg. Etym., ovum, egg.

Ovipositing. The laying of eggs.

Ovipositing. Egg laying.

Oxide. The combination of a metal with oxygen; rust is oxide of iron.

Oxide. The combination of a metal with oxygen; rust is iron oxide.

Oxygen. One of the constituent parts of the air of the atmosphere; that part which supports life. For a farther explanation of the word, consult elementary works on chemistry.

O2. One of the components of the air in the atmosphere; the part that supports life. For more information on the term, check out basic chemistry texts.

Pachydermata. An order of quadrupeds, including the elephant, rhinoceros, horse, pig, &c., distinguished by having thick skins. Etym., παχυς, pachus, thick, and δερμα, derma, skin, or hide.

Elephants. An order of four-legged animals, including the elephant, rhinoceros, horse, pig, etc., known for their thick skin. Etym., παχυς, pachus, thick, and δερμα, derma, skin or hide.

Pachydermatous. Belonging to Pachydermata.

Pachydermatous. Related to Pachydermata.

Palæotherium, Paleothere. A fossil extinct quadruped, belonging to the order Pachydermata, resembling a pig, or tapir, but of great size. Etym., παλαιος, palaios, ancient, and θηριον, therion, wild beast.

Palæotherium, Paleothere. A fossilized extinct four-legged animal, part of the order Pachydermata, that looks like a large pig or tapir. Etym., παλαιος, palaios, ancient, and θηριον, therion, wild beast.

Paleontology. The science which treats of fossil remains, both animal and vegetable. Etym., παλαιος, palaios, ancient, οντα, onta, beings, and λογος, logos, a discourse.

Paleo. The science that studies fossil remains, including both animals and plants. Etym., παλαιος, palaios, ancient, οντα, onta, beings, and λογος, logos, a discourse.

Pelagian, Pelagic. Belonging to the deep sea. Etym., pelagus, sea.

Pelagian, Pelagic. Related to the deep sea. Etym., pelagus, sea.

Peperino. An Italian name for a particular kind of volcanic rock, formed like tuff, by the cementing together of volcanic sand, cinders, or scoriæ, &c.

Peperino. An Italian term for a specific type of volcanic rock, created similar to tuff, by the bonding of volcanic sand, cinders, or scoria, etc.

Petroleum. A liquid mineral pitch, so called because it is seen to ooze like oil out of the rock. Etym., petra, rock, and oleum, oil.

Oil. A liquid mineral substance, named for its oil-like seepage from rocks. Etym., petra, rock, and oleum, oil.

Phænogamous or Phanerogamic Plants. A name given by Linnæus to those plants in which the reproductive organs are apparent. Etym., φανερος, phaneros, evident, or φαινω, phaino, to show, and γαμος, gamos, marriage.

Flowering or Seed Plants. This is a term coined by Linnaeus for plants where the reproductive organs are visible. Etym., φανερος, phaneros, evident, or φαινω, phaino, to show, and γαμος, gamos, marriage.

Phlegræan Fields. Campi Phlegræi, or "the Burnt Fields." The country around Naples, so named by the Greeks, from the traces of igneous action everywhere visible.

Phlegraean Fields. Campi Phlegræi, or "the Burnt Fields." The area around Naples, named by the Greeks because of the signs of volcanic activity that are visible everywhere.

Phonolite. See "Clinkstone."

Phonolite. See "Clinkstone."

Phryganea. A genus of four-winged insects, the larvæ of which, called caddis-worms, are used by anglers as a bait.

Phryganea. A genus of four-winged insects, whose larvae, known as caddis-worms, are used by anglers as bait.

Physics. The department of science which treats of the properties of natural bodies, laws of motion, &c.; sometimes called natural philosophy and mechanical philosophy. Etym., φυσις, physis, nature.

Physics. The branch of science that studies the properties of natural objects, the laws of motion, etc.; sometimes referred to as natural philosophy and mechanical philosophy. Etym., φυσις, physis, nature.

Phytology, Phytological. The department of science which relates to plants—synonymous with, botany and botanical. Etym., φυτον, phyton, plant, and λογος, logos, discourse.

Plant science, Plant science-related. The branch of science that focuses on plants—similar to, botany and botanical. Etym., φυτον, phyton, plant, and λογος, logos, discourse.

Phytophagous. Plant-eating. Etym., φυτον, phyton, plant, and φαγειν, phagein, to eat.

Herbivorous. Plant-eating. Etym., φυτον, phyton, plant, and φαγειν, phagein, to eat.

Pisolite. A stone possessing a structure like an agglutination of peas. Etym., πισον, pison, pea, and λιθος, lithos, stone.

Pisolite. A type of stone that has a structure resembling a bunch of peas stuck together. Etym., πισον, pison, pea, and λιθος, lithos, stone.

Pistia. P. 618. The plant mentioned by Malte-Brun is probably the Pistia Stratiotes, a floating plant, related to English duckweed, but very much larger.

Pistia. P. 618. The plant referred to by Malte-Brun is likely the Pistia Stratiotes, a floating plant that’s related to English duckweed but is significantly larger.

Pit Coal. Ordinary coal; called so, because it is obtained by sinking pits in the ground.

Coal Mining. Regular coal; called that because it's extracted by digging pits in the earth.

Pitchstone. A rock of a uniform texture, belonging to the unstratified and volcanic classes, which has an unctuous appearance like indurated pitch.

Pitchstone. A type of rock with a consistent texture, categorized within the unlayered and volcanic types, that has a slick look similar to hardened pitch.

Plastic Clay. One of the beds of the Eocene Tertiary Period; so called, because it is used for making pottery. The formation to which this name is applied is a series of beds chiefly sands, with which the clay is associated. Etym., πλασσω, plasso, to form or fashion.

Plasticine. One of the layers from the Eocene Tertiary Period; it's called that because it’s used for making pottery. The formation referred to by this name consists mainly of sand layers that are associated with the clay. Etym., πλασσω, plasso, to shape or mold.

Plesiosaurus. A fossil extinct amphibious animal, resembling the saurian, or lizard and crocodile tribe. Etym., πλησιον, plesion, near to, and σαυρα, saura, a lizard.

Plesiosaurus. An extinct fossil amphibious animal that looks like a lizard or crocodile. Etym., πλησιον, plesion, near to, and σαυρα, saura, a lizard.

Pliocene, Older and Newer. Two divisions of the Tertiary Period which are the most modern, and of which the largest part of the fossil shells are of recent species. Etym., πλειων, pleion, more, and καινος, kainos, recent.

Pliocene, Older and Newer. Two divisions of the Tertiary Period that are the most contemporary, with the majority of the fossil shells being of recent species. Etym., πλειων, pleion, more, and καινος, kainos, recent.

Plutonic Action. The influence of volcanic heat and other subterranean causes under pressure.

Plutonic Energy. The effect of volcanic heat and other underground factors under pressure.

Plutonic Rocks. Granite, porphyry, and other igneous rocks supposed to have consolidated from a melted state at a great depth from the surface.

Plutonic rocks. Granite, porphyry, and other igneous rocks are thought to have formed from melted material at significant depths below the surface.

Poliparia. Corals. A numerous class of invertehrated animals, belonging to the great division called Radiata.

Polyp colonies. Corals. A large group of invertebrate animals, part of the major category known as Radiata.

Porphyry. An unstratified or igneous rock. The term is as old as the time of Pliny, and was applied to a red rock with small, angular, white bodies diffused through it, which are crystallized felspar, brought from Egypt. The term is hence applied to every species of unstratifled rock in which detached crystals or felspar or some other mineral are diffused through a base of other mineral composition. Etym., πορφυρα, porphyra, purple.

Porphyry. A type of unstratified or igneous rock. The term has been around since the time of Pliny and was originally used to describe a red rock with small, angular, white crystals dispersed throughout it, which are crystallized feldspar from Egypt. As a result, the term is now used for any type of unstratified rock that contains detached crystals of feldspar or other minerals mixed in with a different mineral base. Etym., πορφυρα, porphyra, purple.

Portland Limestone, Portland Beds. A series of limestone strata, belonging to the upper part of the Oolite Group, found chiefly in England in the Island of Portland on the coast of Dorsetshire. The great supply of the building-stone used in London is from these quarries.

Portland Limestone, Portland Formation. A set of limestone layers that are part of the upper section of the Oolite Group, primarily located in England on the Isle of Portland off the coast of Dorset. The main sources of building stone used in London come from these quarries.

Pozzuolana. Volcanic ashes, largely used as mortar for buildings, similar in nature to what is called in this country Roman cement. It gets its name from Puzzuoli, a town in the Bay of Naples, from which it is shipped in large quantities to all parts of the Mediterranean.

Pozzolana. Volcanic ash that's mostly used as mortar for buildings, similar to what we call Roman cement in this country. It gets its name from Puzzuoli, a town in the Bay of Naples, where it is shipped in large quantities to various parts of the Mediterranean.

Precipitate. Substances which, having been dissolved in a fluid, are separated from it by combining chemically and forming a solid, which falls to the bottom of the fluid. This process is the opposite to that of chemical solution.

Precipitate. Substances that have been dissolved in a fluid are separated from it by chemically reacting and forming a solid, which settles at the bottom of the fluid. This process is the opposite of chemical solution.

Producta. An extinct genus of fossil bivalve shells occurring only in the older secondary rocks. It is closely allied to the living genus Terebratula.

Product. An extinct group of fossil bivalve shells found only in older secondary rocks. It is closely related to the living genus Terebratula.

Pterodactyl. A flying reptile: species of this genus have been found in the Oolite and Muschelkalk. Some of the finger-joints are lengthened, so as to serve as the expansors of a membranous wing. Hence the name wing-fingered. Etym., πτερον, pteron, a wing, and δακτυλος, dactylos, a finger.

Pterodactyl. A flying reptile: species from this genus have been discovered in the Oolite and Muschelkalk. Some of the finger joints are elongated, allowing them to function as supports for a membrane wing. That's why it's called wing-fingered. Etym., πτερον, pteron, meaning wing, and δακτυλος, dactylos, meaning finger.

Pubescence. The soft hairy down on insects. Etym., pubesco, the first growth of the beard.

Puberty. The fine, soft hair on insects. Etym., pubesco, the initial growth of facial hair.

Puddingstone. See "Conglomerate."

Puddingstone. See "Conglomerate."

Pumice. A light spongy lava, chiefly felspathic, of a white color, produced by gases or watery vapor getting access to the particular kind of glassy lava called obsidian, when in a state of fusion; it may be called the froth of melted volcanic glass. The word comes from the Latin name of the stone, pumex.

Pumice stone. A lightweight, spongy lava that is mainly made of feldspar and typically white in color, created when gases or steam come into contact with a specific type of glassy lava known as obsidian while it’s melting; it can be described as the foam of molten volcanic glass. The term comes from the Latin word for the stone, pumex.

Purbeck Limestone, Purbeck Beds. Limestone strata, belonging to the Wealden Group, which intervenes between the Greensand and the Oolite.

Purbeck Limestone, Purbeck Formation. Limestone layers that are part of the Wealden Group, located between the Greensand and the Oolite.

Pyrites. (Iron.) A compound of sulphur and iron, found usually in yellow shining-crystals like brass, and in almost every rock, stratified and unstratifled. The shining metallic bodies so often seen in common roofing slate are a familiar example of the mineral. The word is Greek, and comes from πυρ, pyr, fire; because tinder particular circumstances, the stone produces spontaneous heat, and even inflammation.

Fool's gold. (Iron.) A compound of sulfur and iron, usually found in shiny yellow crystals like brass, and present in nearly every type of rock, both layered and unlayered. The shiny metallic pieces often seen in common roofing slate are a well-known example of this mineral. The word is Greek, derived from πυρ, pyr, meaning fire; because under certain conditions, the stone can generate spontaneous heat and even catch fire.

Pyrometer. An instrument for measuring intense degrees of heat.

Infrared thermometer. A device for measuring high temperatures.

Quadrumana. The order of mammiferous animals to which apes belong. Etym., quadrus, a derivative of the Latin word for the number four, and manus, hand, the four feet of those animals being in some degree usable as hands.

Primates. The group of mammal species that includes apes. Etym., quadrus, derived from the Latin word for the number four, and manus, meaning hand, since the four limbs of these animals can somewhat function like hands.

Qua-qua-versal Dip. The dip of beds to all points of the compass around a centre, as in the case of beds of lava round the crater of a volcano. Etym., quâ-quâ-versum, on every side.

Multi-dimensional Dip. The tilt of layers extending in all directions from a central point, like lava layers surrounding a volcano's crater. Etym., quâ-quâ-versum, from every side.

Quartz. A German provincial term, universally adopted in scientific language for a simple mineral composed of pure silex, or earth of flints: rock-crystal is an example.

Quartz. A term from German provinces that has been widely accepted in scientific language for a straightforward mineral made of pure silica, or flint earth: rock crystal is one example.

Quartzite or Quartz Rock. An aggregate of grains of quartz, sometimes passing into compact quartz.

Quartzite or Quartz Crystal. A collection of quartz grains, occasionally forming solid quartz.

Red Marl. A term often applied to the New Red Sandstone.

Red Marl. A term commonly used to refer to the New Red Sandstone.

Reticulate. A structure of cross lines, like a net, is said to be reticulated, from rete, a net.

Networked. A structure with crossed lines, resembling a net, is called reticulated, from rete, meaning net.

Rock Salt. Common culinary salt, or muriate of soda, found in vast solid masses or beds, in different formations, extensively in the New Red Sandstone formation, as in Cheshire; and it is then called rock-salt.

Sea Salt. Regular table salt, or sodium chloride, is found in large solid masses or deposits, in various formations, particularly in the New Red Sandstone formation, like in Cheshire; and it’s referred to as rock-salt.

Rubble. A term applied by quarry-men to the upper fragmentary and decomposed portion of a mass of stone.

Debris. A term used by quarry workers to describe the upper broken and weathered part of a block of stone.

Ruminantia. Animals which ruminate or chew the cud, such as the ox, deer, &c. Etym., the Latin verb rumino, meaning the same thing.

Ruminants. Animals that ruminate or chew the cud, like the ox, deer, etc. Etym., the Latin verb rumino, meaning the same thing.

Saccharoid, Saccharine. When a stone has a texture resembling that of loaf-sugar. Etym., σακχαρ, sacchar, sugar, and ειδος, eidos, form. Fig. 100.Salient Angle.

Sugar, Sweet. When a stone has a texture like that of loaf sugar. Etym., σακχαρ, sacchar, sugar, and ειδος, eidos, form. Fig. 100.Salient Angle.

Salient Angle. In a zigzag line a a are the salient angles, b b the re-entering angles. Etym., salire, to leap or bound forward.

Key Angle. In a zigzag line a a are the salient angles, b b the re-entering angles. Etym., salire, to leap or jump forward.

Salt Springs. Springs of water containing a large quantity of common salt. They are very abundant in Cheshire and Worcestershire, and culinary salt is obtained from them by mere evaporation.

Salt Springs. Springs of water that have a high concentration of regular salt. They are quite plentiful in Cheshire and Worcestershire, and table salt is extracted from them simply through evaporation.

Sandstone. Any stone which is composed of an agglutination of grains of sand, whether calcareous, siliceous, or of any other mineral nature.

Sandstone. Any rock made up of a collection of sand grains, whether they are made of calcium, silica, or any other type of mineral.

Saurian. Any animal belonging to the lizard tribe. Etym., σαυρα, saura, a lizard.

Dinosaur. Any animal that is part of the lizard family. Etym., σαυρα, saura, a lizard.

Saxicavous. Hollowing out stone.

Saxicavous. Carving out stone.

Schist is often used as synonymous with slate; but it may be very useful to distinguish between a schistose and a slaty structure. The hypogene or primary schists, as they are termed, such as gneiss, mica-schist, and others, cannot be split into an indefinite number of parallel laminæ like rocks which have a true slaty cleavage. The uneven schistose layers of mica-schist and gneiss are probably layers of deposition, which have assumed a crystalline texture. See "Cleavage." Etym., schistus, adj. Latin, that which may be split.

Schist is often used interchangeably with slate; however, it can be quite helpful to differentiate between schistose and slaty structures. The hypogene or primary schists, such as gneiss, mica-schist, and others, cannot be divided into a limitless number of parallel layers like rocks that have a true slaty cleavage. The uneven schistose layers of mica-schist and gneiss are likely layers of deposition that have taken on a crystalline texture. See "Cleavage." Etym., schistus, adj. Latin, meaning that which can be split.

Schistose Rocks. See "Schist."

Schistose Rocks. See "Schist."

Scoriæ. Volcanic cinders. The word is Latin for cinders.

Scoria. Volcanic cinders. The word is Latin for cinders.

Seams. Thin layers which separate two strata of greater magnitude.

Seams. Thin layers that separate two larger layers.

Secondary Strata. An extensive series of the stratified rocks which compose the crust of the globe, with certain characters in common, which distinguish them from another series below them called primary, and from a third series above them called tertiary.

Secondary Layers. A large collection of layered rocks that make up the Earth's crust, sharing certain characteristics that set them apart from a lower group known as primary and an upper group referred to as tertiary.

Secular Refrigeration. The periodical cooling and consolidation of the globe from a supposed original state of fluidity from heat. Sæculum, age or period.

Refrigeration without religious influence. The regular cooling and solidification of the Earth from an assumed initial state of liquid due to heat. Sæculum, age or period.

Sedimentary Rocks are those which have been formed by their materials having been thrown down from a state of suspension or solution in water.

Sedimentary Rocks are those that have formed when their materials have settled out from a state of suspension or solution in water.

Selenite. Crystallized gypsum, or sulphate of lime—a simple mineral.

Selenite. Crystallized gypsum, or sulfate of lime—a straightforward mineral.

Septaria. Flattened balls of stone, generally a kind of iron-stone, which, on being split, are seen to be separated in their interior into irregular masses. Etym., septa, inclosures.

Septaria. Flattened balls of stone, usually a type of ironstone, that reveal irregular masses inside when they are split open. Etym., septa, enclosures.

Serpentine. A rock usually containing much magnesian earth, for the most part unstratified, but sometimes appearing to be an altered or metamorphic stratified rock. Its name is derived from frequently presenting contrasts of color, like the skin of some serpents.

Snake-like. A type of rock that usually has a lot of magnesium-rich material, mostly unlayered, but sometimes looks like a transformed or metamorphic layered rock. Its name comes from its common color variations, which are similar to the skin of certain snakes.

Shale. A provincial term, adopted by geologists, to express an indurated slaty clay. Etym., German schalen, to peel, to split.

Shale rock. A term used by geologists to refer to a hardened, layered clay. Etym., German schalen, meaning to peel or to split.

Shell Marl. A deposit of clay, peat, and other substances mixed with shells, which collects at the bottom of lakes.

Shell Marls. A layer of clay, peat, and other materials combined with shells that gathers at the bottom of lakes.

Shingle. The loose and completely water-worn gravel on the sea-shore.

Shingle roof. The loose and fully water-worn gravel on the beach.

Silex. The name of one of the pure earths, being the Latin word for flint, which is wholly composed of that earth. French geologists have applied it as a generic 814 name for all minerals composed entirely of that earth, of which there are many of different external forms.

Silex. The name of one of the pure earths, which is the Latin word for flint, made entirely of that earth. French geologists have used it as a general 814 term for all minerals that are completely made up of that earth, of which there are many different external forms.

Silica. One of the pure earths. Etym., silex, flint, because found in that mineral.

Silicon dioxide. One of the purest earth materials. Etym., silex, flint, because it is found in that mineral.

Silicate. A chemical compound of silica and another substance, such as silicate of iron. Consult elementary works on chemistry.

Silicate. A chemical compound made of silica and another substance, like iron silicate. Check basic chemistry textbooks for more information.

Siliceous. Of or belonging to the earth of flint. Etym., silex, which see. A siliceous rock is one mainly composed of silex.

Silica-based. Relating to the earth of flint. Etym., silex, see there. A siliceous rock is one that is primarily made up of silex.

Silicified. Any substance that is petrified or mineralized by siliceous earth.

Silica-treated. Any material that has been turned to stone or mineralized by siliceous earth.

Silt. The more comminuted sand, clay, and earth, which is transported by running water. It is often accumulated by currents in banks. Thus the mouth of a river is silted up when its entrance into the sea is impeded by such accumulation of loose materials.

Silt. The finer particles of sand, clay, and soil that are carried by flowing water. It often builds up along riverbanks. This is why the mouth of a river gets silted up when its flow into the sea is blocked by a buildup of loose materials.

Simple Mineral. Individual mineral substances, as distinguished from rocks, which last are usually an aggregation of simple minerals. They are not simple in regard to their nature; for when subjected to chemical analysis, they are found to consist of a variety of different substances. Pyrites is a simple mineral in the sense we use the term, but it is a chemical compound of sulphur and iron.

Basic Mineral. Individual mineral substances, unlike rocks, which are usually made up of a mix of simple minerals. They're not simple in terms of their composition; when analyzed chemically, they consist of various different substances. Pyrite is a simple mineral in the way we define it, but it's actually a chemical compound made up of sulfur and iron.

Sinter, Calcareous or Siliceous. A German name for a rock precipitated from mineral waters. Etym., sintern, to drop.

Sinter, Calcite, or Silica. A German term for rock formed from mineral waters. Etym., sintern, to drop.

Slate. See "Cleavage" and "Schist."

Slate. See "Cleavage" and "Schist."

Solfatara. A volcanic vent from which sulphur, sulphureous, watery, and acid vapors and gases are emitted.

Solfatara. A volcanic vent that releases sulfur, sulfurous, watery, and acidic vapors and gases.

Sporules. The reproductory corpuscula (minute bodies) of cryptogamic plants. Etym., σπορα, spora, a seed.

Spores. The reproductive bodies (tiny units) of cryptogamic plants. Etym., σπορα, spora, a seed.

Stalactite. When water holding lime in solution deposits it as it drops from the roof of a cavern, long rods of stone hang down like icicles, and these are called stalactites. Etym., σταλαζω, stalazo, to drop.

Stalactite. When water that carries lime in solution drips from the ceiling of a cave, it leaves behind long stone formations that hang down like icicles. These formations are called stalactites. Etym., σταλαζω, stalazo, to drop.

Stalagmite. When water holding lime in solution drops on the floor of a cavern, the water evaporating leaves a crust composed of layers of limestone: such a crust is called stalagmite, from σταλαγμα, stalagma, a drop, in opposition to stalactite, which see.

Stalagmite. When water containing dissolved lime drips onto the floor of a cave, the evaporating water leaves behind a layer made of limestone: this layer is called a stalagmite, from the Greek word σταλαγμα, stalagma, meaning a drop, in contrast to stalactite, which you can look up.

Statical Figure. The figure which results from the equilibrium of forces. From στατος, statos, stable, or standing still.

Statistical Figure. The figure that comes from the balance of forces. From στατος, statos, stable, or at rest.

Sternum. The breast-bone, or the flat bone occupying the front of the chest.

Sternum. The breastbone, or the flat bone located at the front of the chest.

Stilbite. A crystallized simple mineral, usually white, one of the Zeolite family, frequently included in the mass of the Trap-rocks.

Stilbite. A crystallized, simple mineral that's usually white, part of the Zeolite family, often found mixed in with Trap rocks.

Stratified. Rocks arranged in the form of strata, which see.

Layered. Rocks sorted into layers called strata, which see.

Stratification. An arrangement of rocks in strata, which see.

Social hierarchy. An arrangement of rocks in layers, which see.

Strata, Stratum. The term stratum, derived from the Latin verb struo, to strew or lay out, means a bed or mass of matter spread out over a certain surface by the action of water, or in some cases by wind. The deposition of successive layers of sand and gravel in the bed of a river, or in a canal, affords a perfect illustration both of the form and origin of stratification. A large portion of the masses constituting the earth's crust are thus stratified, the successive strata of a given rock preserving a general parallelism to each other; but the planes of stratification not being perfectly parallel throughout a great extent like the planes of cleavage, which see.

Layers, Layer. The term stratum, which comes from the Latin verb struo, meaning to spread out or lay down, refers to a layer or accumulation of material that covers a specific area due to the action of water or, in some cases, wind. The way layers of sand and gravel build up in a riverbed or canal perfectly illustrates both the shape and formation of stratification. A significant part of the earth's crust is made up of these layers, with the various strata of a particular rock generally remaining parallel to one another; however, the layers of stratification are not perfectly parallel over large distances like the planes of cleavage, which see.

Strike. The direction or line of bearing of strata, which is always at right angles to their prevailing dip.

Striking. The direction or alignment of rock layers, which is always at a right angle to their main slope.

Stufas. Jets of steam issuing from fissures in volcanic regions at a temperature often above the boiling point.

Stoves. Streams of steam coming from cracks in volcanic areas at temperatures frequently exceeding the boiling point.

Subapennines. Low hills which skirt or lie at the foot of the great chain of the Apennines in Italy. The term. Subapennine is applied geologically to a series of strata of the Older Pliocene Period.

Subapennines. Low hills that border or sit at the base of the great chain of the Apennines in Italy. The term Subapennine is used in geology to refer to a series of layers from the Older Pliocene Period.

Syenite. A kind of granite; so called, because it was brought from Syene in Egypt.

Syenite. A type of granite; it's called that because it was sourced from Syene in Egypt.

Talus. When fragments are broken off by the action of the weather from the face of a steep rock, as they accumulate at its foot, they form a sloping heap, called a 815 talus. The term is borrowed from the language of fortification, where talus means the outside of a wall of which the thickness is diminished by degrees, as it rises in height, to make it the firmer.

Talus. When pieces break off from a steep rock due to weathering and pile up at its base, they create a sloping mound known as a 815 talus. The term comes from fortification terminology, where talus refers to the outer part of a wall that gradually narrows as it rises in height to increase stability.

Tarsi. The feet in insects, which are articulated, and formed of five or a less number of joints.

Tarsier. The feet of insects, which are jointed and made up of five or fewer segments.

Tertiary Strata. A series of sedimentary rocks, with characters which distinguish them from two other great series of strata—the secondary and primary—which lie beneath them.

Tertiary Layers. A series of sedimentary rocks that have features that set them apart from the two other main series of strata—the secondary and primary—which lie beneath them.

Testacea. Molluscous animals, having a shelly covering. Etym., testa, a shell, such as snails, whelks, oysters, &c.

Testa. Soft-bodied animals with a shell covering. Etym. testa, a shell, like snails, whelks, oysters, &c.

Thallogens. A class of flowerless plants including all those that have no defined axis, stem, or leaves; as Lichens, Seaweeds, and Fungi. Etym., θαλλος, thallos, a branch, and γενεσις, genesis, increase.

Thallogens. A group of flowerless plants that lack a defined axis, stem, or leaves; such as lichens, seaweeds, and fungi. Etym., θαλλος, thallos, a branch, and γενεσις, genesis, growth.

Thermal. Hot. Etym., θερμος, thermos, hot.

Thermal. Hot. Etym., θερμος, thermos, hot.

Thermo-electricity. Electricity developed by heat.

Thermo-electricity. Heat-generated electricity.

Thin Out. When a stratum, in the course of its prolongation in any direction, becomes gradually less in thickness, the two surfaces approach nearer and nearer; and when at last they meet, the stratum is said to thin out or disappear.

Thin out. When a layer, as it extends in any direction, becomes gradually thinner, the two surfaces get closer and closer together; and when they finally meet, the layer is said to thin out or vanish.

Trachyte. A variety of lava essentially composed of glassy felspar, and frequently having detached crystals of felspar in the base or body of the stone, giving it the structure of porphyry. It sometimes contains hornblende and augite; and when these last predominate, the trachyte passes into the varieties of trap, called Greenstone, Basalt, Dolorite, &c. The term is derived from τραχυς, trachus, rough, because the rock has a peculiar rough feel.

Trachyte. A type of lava mainly made up of glassy feldspar, often featuring separate crystals of feldspar in the stone, which gives it a porphyritic structure. It can sometimes include hornblende and augite; and when these become the main components, trachyte transitions into varieties of trap, known as Greenstone, Basalt, Dolerite, etc. The name comes from τραχυς, trachus, meaning rough, because the rock has a distinct rough texture.

Trap and Trappean Rocks. Volcanic rocks composed of felspar, augite, and hornblende. The various proportions and state of aggregation of these simple minerals, and differences in external forms, give rise to varieties, which have received distinct appellations, such as Basalt, Amygdaloid, Dolorite, Greenstone, and others. The term is derived from trappa, a Swedish word for stair, because the rocks of this class sometimes occur in large tabular masses, rising one above another like steps.

Trap and Trappean Rocks. Volcanic rocks made up of feldspar, augite, and hornblende. The different proportions and arrangement of these basic minerals, along with variations in their external shapes, create different types, which have been given specific names like Basalt, Amygdaloid, Dolerite, Greenstone, and others. The name comes from trappa, a Swedish word for stair, because these rocks can sometimes form large flat layers that stack on top of each other like steps.

Travertin. A white concretionary limestone, usually hard and semi-crystalline, deposited from the water of springs holding lime in solution.—Etym. This stone was called by the ancients Lapis Tiburtinus, the stone being formed in great quantity by the river Anio, at Tibur, near Rome. Some suppose travertin to be an abbreviation of trasterverino from transtiburtinus.

Travertine stone. A white, solid limestone that’s usually hard and semi-crystalline, formed from water from springs containing dissolved lime.—Etym. The ancient Romans referred to this stone as Lapis Tiburtinus, as it was found in large quantities along the Anio River at Tibur, near Rome. Some think travertine is a shortened form of trasterverino, which comes from transtiburtinus.

Tripoli. The name of a powder used for polishing metals and stones, first imported from Tripoli, which, as well as a certain kind of siliceous stone of the same name, has been lately found to be composed of the flinty cases of Infusoria.

Tripoli. The name of a powder used for polishing metals and stones, first imported from Tripoli, which, along with a specific type of siliceous stone of the same name, has recently been discovered to be made up of the flinty shells of Infusoria.

Trophi, of Insects. Organs which form the mouth, consisting of an upper and under lip, and comprising the parts called mandibles, maxillæ, and palpi.

Trophies, of Insects. The structures that make up the mouth, consisting of an upper and lower lip, and including the parts known as mandibles, maxillae, and palpi.

Tufa, Calcareous. A porous rock deposited by calcareous waters on their exposure to the air, and usually containing portions of plants and other organic substances incrusted with carbonate of lime. The more solid form of the same deposit is called "travertin," into which it passes.

Tufa, Calcium-rich. A porous rock formed by calcium-rich waters when they come into contact with air, often containing bits of plants and other organic materials coated with calcium carbonate. The denser version of this deposit is known as "travertine," which it transitions into.

Tufa, Volcanic. See "Tuff."

Tufa, volcanic. See "Tuff."

Tufaceous. A rock with the texture of tuff, or tufa, which see.

Tuff. A rock that has the texture of tuff or tufa, which you can refer to for more information.

Tuff, or Tufa Volcanic. An Italian name for a variety of volcanic rock of an earthy texture, seldom very compact, and composed of an agglutination of fragments of scoriæ and loose materials ejected from a volcano.

Tough, or Tufa Volcanic. An Italian term for a type of volcanic rock with a rough texture, usually not very dense, made up of a mix of fragments of scoria and loose materials thrown out by a volcano.

Turbinated. Shells which have a spiral or screw-form structure. Etym., turbinatus, made like a top.

Turbinated. Shells that have a spiral or screw-like structure. Etym., turbinatus, shaped like a top.

Turrilite. An extinct genus of chambered shells, allied to the Ammonites, having the siphuncle near the dorsal margin.

Turrilite. An extinct group of chambered shells related to the Ammonites, featuring the siphuncle close to the upper edge.

Unconformable. See "Conformable."

Unconformable. See "Conformable."

Unoxidized, Unoxidated. Not combined with oxygen.

Unoxidized, Unoxidated. Not combined with oxygen.

Veins, Mineral. Cracks in rocks filled up by substances different from the rock, which may either be earthy or metallic. Veins are sometimes many yards wide; 816 and they ramify or branch off into innumerable smaller parts, often as slender as threads, like the veins in an animal, hence their name.

Veins, Mineral. Cracks in rocks filled with materials different from the rock itself, which can be either earthy or metallic. Veins can sometimes be several yards wide; 816 and they spread out or branch into countless smaller parts, often as thin as threads, like the veins in an animal, which is how they got their name.

Vertebrated Animals. A great division of the animal kingdom, including all those which are furnished with a back-bone, as the mammalia, birds, reptiles, and fishes. The separate joints of the back-bone are called vertebræ, from the Latin verb verto, to turn.

Vertebrate Animals. A major category of the animal kingdom that includes all creatures with a backbone, such as mammals, birds, reptiles, and fish. The individual segments of the backbone are called vertebræ, from the Latin verb verto, meaning to turn.

Vesicle. A small, circular, inclosed space, like a little bladder. Etym., diminutive of vesica, Latin for a bladder.

Vesicle. A small, round, enclosed space, similar to a tiny bladder. Etym., diminutive of vesica, Latin for bladder.

Vitrification. The conversion of a body into glass by heat.

Vitrification. The process of turning a substance into glass through heating.

Volcanic Bombs. Volcanoes throw out sometimes detached masses of melted lava, which, as they fall, assume rounded forms (like bomb-shells), and are often elongated into a pear-shape.

Volcanic rocks. Volcanoes occasionally eject chunks of molten lava that, as they fall, take on rounded shapes (like bomb shells) and are often stretched into a pear shape.

Volcanic Foci. The subterranean centres of action in volcanoes, where the heat is supposed to be in the highest degree of energy.

Volcanic Hotspots. The underground centers of activity in volcanoes, where the heat is believed to be at its most intense.

Wacke. A rock nearly allied to basalt, of which it may be regarded as a soft and earthy variety.

Wacke. A type of rock closely related to basalt, which can be seen as a softer and earthier version of it.

Warp. The deposit of muddy waters, artificially introduced into low lands. See p. 326.

Warp. The accumulation of muddy water, intentionally brought into low-lying areas. See p. 326.

Zeolite. A family of simple minerals, including stilbite, mesotype, analcime, and some others, usually found in the trap or volcanic rocks. Some of the most common varieties swell or boil up when exposed to the blow-pipe, and hence the name of ζεο, zeô, to boil, and λιθος, lithos, stone.

Zeolite. A group of simple minerals, including stilbite, mesotype, analcime, and a few others, typically found in trap or volcanic rocks. Some of the more common types expand or bubble up when exposed to a blowpipe, which is where the name comes from: ζεο, zeô, meaning to boil, and λιθος, lithos, meaning stone.

Zoophites. Corals, sponges, and other aquatic animals allied to them; so called because, while they are the habitation of animals, they are fixed to the ground, and have the form of plants. Etym., ζωον, zoon, animal, and φυτον, phyton, plant.

Animal life forms. Corals, sponges, and other aquatic creatures related to them; they're called this because, even though they serve as homes for animals, they are anchored to the ground and resemble plants. Etym., ζωον, zoon, animal, and φυτον, phyton, plant.

FOOTNOTES:

1 Essays on the Philosophy of the Hindoos.

1 Essays on the Philosophy of the Hindus.

2 Institutes of Hindoo Law, or the Ordinances of Menù, from the Sanscrit, translated by Sir William Jones, 1796.

2 Institutes of Hindu Law, or the Rules of Manu, from the Sanskrit, translated by Sir William Jones, 1796.

3 Menù, Inst. c. i. 66, and 67.

3 Menu, Inst. c. i. 66, and 67.

4 Herodot. Euterpe, 12.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Herodotus. Euterpe, 12.

5 A Persian MS. copy of the historian Ferishta, in the library of the East India Company, relating to the rise and progress of the Mahomedan empire in India, was procured by Colonel Briggs from the library of Tippoo Sultan in 1799; which has been referred to at some length by Dr. Buckland. (Geol. Trans. 2d Series, vol. ii. part iii. p. 389.)

5 A Persian manuscript by the historian Ferishta, found in the East India Company’s library and detailing the rise and development of the Muslim empire in India, was obtained by Colonel Briggs from Tippoo Sultan’s library in 1799; this has been discussed in detail by Dr. Buckland. (Geol. Trans. 2d Series, vol. ii. part iii. p. 389.)

6 See Davis on "The Chinese," published by the Soc. for the Diffus. of Use. Know. vol. i. pp. 137, 147.

6 Check out Davis on "The Chinese," published by the Society for the Diffusion of Useful Knowledge, vol. i, pp. 137, 147.

7 Humboldt et Bonpland, Voy. Relat. Hist. vol. i. p. 30.

7 Humboldt and Bonpland, Voy. Relat. Hist. vol. i. p. 30.

8 Prichard's Egypt. Mythol. p. 177.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Prichard's Egypt. Mythology. p. 177.

9 Plut. de Defectu Oraculorum, cap. 12. Censorinus de Die Natali. See also Prichard's Egypt. Mythol. p. 182.

9 Plutarch on the Failure of Oracles, chapter 12. Censorinus on the Day of Birth. See also Prichard's Egypt. Mythology, page 182.

10 Prichard's Egypt. Mythol. p. 182.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Prichard's Egypt. Mythology. p. 182.

11 Prichard's Egypt. Mythol. p. 193.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Prichard's Egypt. Mythol. p. 193.

12 Plato's Timæus.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Plato's Timaeus.

13 Ovid's Metamor. lib. 15.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Ovid's Metamorphoses, book 15.

14 Eluvie mons est deductus in æquor, v. 267. The meaning of this last verse is somewhat obscure; but, taken with the context, may be supposed to allude to the abrading power of floods, torrents, and rivers.

14 Eluvie mons is brought down to the sea, v. 267. The meaning of this last line is a bit unclear; however, in context, it might be understood as referring to the eroding power of floods, torrents, and rivers.

15 The impregnation from new mineral springs, caused by earthquakes in volcanic countries, is perhaps here alluded to.

15 The fertilization from new mineral springs, triggered by earthquakes in volcanic regions, is possibly referenced here.

16 That is probably an allusion to the escape of inflammable gas, like that in the district of Baku, west of the Caspian; at Pietramala, in the Tuscan Apennines; and several other places.

16 That is likely a reference to the release of flammable gas, similar to what occurs in the Baku region, west of the Caspian; in Pietramala, in the Tuscan Apennines; and in several other locations.

17 Many of those described seem fanciful fictions, like the virtue still so commonly attributed to mineral waters.

17 Many of the things mentioned seem like fanciful stories, similar to the goodness still often associated with mineral waters.

18 Raspe, in a learned and judicious essay (De Novis Insulis, cap. 19), has made it appear extremely probable that all the traditions of certain islands in the Mediterranean having at some former time frequently shifted their positions, and at length become stationary, originated in the great change produced in their form by earthquakes and submarine eruptions, of which there have been modern examples in the new islands raised in the time of history. When the series of convulsions ended, the island was said to become fixed.

18 Raspe, in a well-informed and thoughtful essay (De Novis Insulis, cap. 19), has shown that it’s highly likely the traditions of certain islands in the Mediterranean, which at one time frequently changed locations and eventually became stable, were influenced by the significant alterations in their shape caused by earthquakes and underwater eruptions, similar to modern examples of new islands that have emerged throughout history. Once the series of disturbances concluded, the island was said to have become fixed.

19 It is not inconsistent with the Hindoo mythology to suppose that Pythagoras might have found in the East not only the system of universal and violent catastrophes and periods of repose in endless succession, but also that of periodical revolutions, effected by the continued agency of ordinary causes. For Brahma, Vishnu, and Siva, the first, second, and third persons of the Hindoo triad, severally represented the Creative, the Preserving, and the Destroying powers of the Deity. The coexistence of these three attributes, all in simultaneous operation, might well accord with the notion of perpetual but partial alterations finally bringing about a complete change. But the fiction expressed in the verses before quoted from Menù of eternal vicissitudes in the vigils and slumbers of Brahma seems accommodated to the system of great general catastrophes followed by new creations and periods of repose.

19 It's not inconsistent with Hindu mythology to think that Pythagoras might have discovered in the East not just the idea of universal and violent catastrophes, along with periods of rest in endless cycles, but also the concept of recurring changes caused by ordinary events. Brahma, Vishnu, and Siva, the first, second, and third figures of the Hindu trinity, represent the Creator, the Preserver, and the Destroyer aspects of the divine. The coexistence of these three traits, all operating at the same time, could align well with the idea of continuous but partial changes ultimately leading to a complete transformation. However, the idea expressed in the previously quoted verses from Menù about eternal changes in Brahma's wakefulness and sleep seems more suited to the concept of major catastrophic events followed by new beginnings and periods of rest.

20 Meteor. lib. i. cap. 12.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Meteor. book 1, chapter 12.

21 De Die Nat.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ From the National.

22 Lib. ii. cap. 14, 15, and 16.

22 Book 2, chapters 14, 15, and 16.

23 Lib. ii. cap. 14, 15, and 16.

23 Lib. ii. cap. 14, 15, and 16.

24 Omne ex integro animal generabitur, dabiturque terris homo inscius scelerum.—Quæst. Nat. iii. c. 29.

24 Every creature will be born whole, and mankind will be unaware of its sins.—Quæst. Nat. iii. c. 29.

25 This author was Regius Professor of Syriac and Arabic at Paris, where, in 1685, he published a Latin translation of many Arabian MSS. on different departments of philosophy. This work has always been considered of high authority.

25 This author was the Regius Professor of Syriac and Arabic in Paris, where, in 1685, he published a Latin translation of various Arabian manuscripts on different areas of philosophy. This work has consistently been regarded as highly authoritative.

26 Gerbanitæ docebant singulos triginta sex mille annos quadringentos, viginti quinque bina ex singulis animalium speciebus produci, marem scilicet ac feminam ex quibus animalia propagantur, huncque inferiorem incolunt orbem. Absoluta autem cœlestium orbium circulatione, quæ illo annorum conficitur spatio, iterum alia producuntur animalium genera et species, quemadmodum et plantarum aliarumque rerum, et primus destruitur ordo, sicque in infinitum producitur.—Histor. Orient Suppl. per Abrahamum Ecchellensem, Syrum Maronitam, cap. 7. et 8. ad calcem Chronici Orientali. Parisiis, e Typ. Regia. 1685, fol.

26 The Gerbanites taught that every 36,425 years, two individuals of each animal species are produced, one male and one female, from which the animals propagate, inhabiting this lower world. However, once the celestial orbits have completed their cycle over that span of years, new genera and species of animals are produced, just like other plants and things; the original order is destroyed, and thus it continues infinitely.—Histor. Orient Suppl. by Abraham Ecchellensem, Syrum Maronitam, chapters 7 and 8, at the end of the Oriental Chronicle. Paris, from the Royal Press. 1685, fol.

I have given the punctuation as in the Paris edition, there being no comma after quinque; but, at the suggestion of M. de Schlegel, I have referred the number twenty-five to the period of years, and not to the number of pairs of each species created at one time, as I had done in the two first editions. Fortis inferred that twenty-five new species only were created at a time; a construction which the passage will not admit. Mém. sur l'Hist. Nat. de l'Italie, vol. i. p. 202.

I have used the punctuation from the Paris edition, which has no comma after quinque; however, based on M. de Schlegel's suggestion, I have interpreted the number twenty-five as referring to years instead of the number of pairs of each species created at once, as I did in the first two editions. Fortis concluded that only twenty-five new species were created at a time, an interpretation that the passage does not support. Mém. sur l'Hist. Nat. de l'Italie, vol. i. p. 202.

27 "Quod enim hoc attollitur aut subsidit, et vel inundat quædam loca, vel ab iis recedit, ejus rei causa non est, quod alia aliis sola humiliora sint aut altiora; sed quod idem solum modò attollitur modò deprimitur, simulque etiam modò attollitur modò deprimitur, mare: itaque vel exundat vel in suum redit locum."

27 "What rises or falls, and either floods certain areas or recedes from them, is not because some places are simply lower or higher than others; rather, it’s that the same land is sometimes raised up and sometimes lowered, and at the same time the sea is raised up or lowered as well: thus it either overflows or returns to its original place."

Posteà, p. 88. "Restat, ut causam adscribamus solo, sive quod mari subest sive quod inundatur; potiùs tamen ei quod mari subest. Hoc enim multò est mobilius, et quod ob humiditatem celeriùs multari possit."—Strabo, Geog. Edit. Almelov. Amst. 1707, lib. 1.

Posteà, p. 88. "It remains to attribute the cause to the soil, whether it is beneath the sea or is flooded; however, it is more likely to the part that is beneath the sea. This part is much more mobile and, due to the moisture, can shift more quickly."—Strabo, Geog. Edit. Almelo v. Amst. 1707, lib. 1.

28 Volcanic eruptions, eruptiones flatuum, in the Latin translations, and in the original Greek, αναφυσηματα, gaseous eruptions? or inflations of land?—Ibid. p. 93.

28 Volcanic eruptions, in the Latin translations called eruptiones flatuum, and in the original Greek, αναφυσηματα, which means gaseous eruptions? or inflations of land?—Ibid. p. 93.

29 Strabo, lib. vi. p. 396.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Strabo, book 6, p. 396.

30 Book iv.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Book 4.

31 L. vi. ch. xiii.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Luke 6:13.

32 Mod. Univ. Hist. vol. ii. chap. iv. section iii.

32 Mod. Univ. Hist. vol. ii. chap. iv. section iii.

33 Montes quandóque fiunt ex causa essentiali, quandóque ex causa accidentali. Ex essentiali causa, ut ex vehementi motu terræ elevatur terra, et fit mons. Accidentali, &c.—De Congelatione Lapidum, ed. Gedani, 1682.

33 Mountains are sometimes formed from essential causes and sometimes from accidental causes. From an essential cause, like when the ground is raised due to a strong earthquake, a mountain is formed. Accidentally, etc.—On the Freezing of Stones, ed. Gedani, 1682.

34 Von Hoff, Geschichte der Veränderungen der Erdoberfläche, vol. i. p. 406, who cites Delisle, bey Hismann Welt- und Völkergeschichte. Alte Geschichte 1ter theil, s. 234.—The Arabian persecutions for heretical dogmas in theology were often very sanguinary. In the same ages wherein learning was most in esteem, the Mahometans were divided into two sects, one of whom maintained that the Koran was increate, and had subsisted in the very essence of God from all eternity; and the other, the Motazalites, who, admitting that the Koran was instituted by God, conceived it to have been first made when revealed to the Prophet at Mecca, and accused their opponents of believing in two eternal beings. The opinions of each of these sects were taken up by different caliphs in succession, and the followers of each sometimes submitted to be beheaded, or flogged till at the point of death, rather than renounce their creed.—Mod. Univ. Hist. vol. ii. ch. iv.

34 Von Hoff, History of Changes in the Earth's Surface, vol. i. p. 406, who cites Delisle, in Hismann World and People History. Ancient History 1st part, p. 234.—The Arabian persecutions for heretical beliefs in theology were often very brutal. During the same periods when education was highly valued, the Muslims were split into two sects: one believed that the Quran was uncreated and had existed in the very essence of God for all eternity; the other, the Mu'tazilites, who acknowledged that the Quran was created by God, thought it first came into being when it was revealed to the Prophet in Mecca, accusing their opponents of believing in two eternal beings. The views of each sect were adopted by different caliphs in succession, and the followers of each sometimes chose to be executed or flogged to the brink of death rather than abandon their beliefs.—Mod. Univ. Hist. vol. ii. ch. iv.

35 Koran, chap. xli.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Quran, chap. 41.

36 Sale's Koran, chap. xi. see note.

36 Sale's Koran, chapter 11. See note.

37 Ibid.

Ibid.

38 Kossa, appointed master to the Caliph Al Mamûd, was author of a book entitled "The history of the Patriarchs and Prophets, from the Creation of the World."—Mod. Univ. Hist. vol. ii. ch. iv.

38 Kossa, who was appointed master to Caliph Al Mamûd, wrote a book called "The History of the Patriarchs and Prophets, from the Creation of the World."—Mod. Univ. Hist. vol. ii. ch. iv.

39 Translated by MM. Chezy and De Sacy, and cited by M. Elie de Beaumont, Ann. des Sci. Nat. 1832.

39 Translated by MM. Chezy and De Sacy, and cited by M. Elie de Beaumont, Ann. des Sci. Nat. 1832.

40 See Venturi's extracts from Da Vinci's MMS. now in Library of Institute of France. They are not mentioned by Brocchi, and my attention was first called to them by Mr. Hallam. L. da Vinci died A. D. 1519.

40 Check out Venturi's excerpts from Da Vinci's MMS, currently available at the Library of the Institute of France. Brocchi doesn't mention them, and I was first made aware of them by Mr. Hallam. Leonardo da Vinci passed away in A. D. 1519.

41 Museum Calceol.—See Brocchi's Discourse on the Progress of the Study of Fossil Conchology in Italy, where some of the following notices on Italian writers will be found more at large.

41 Museum Calceol.—See Brocchi's Discourse on the Progress of the Study of Fossil Conchology in Italy, where you can find more detailed information about some of the following observations on Italian authors.

42 In Sicily, in particular, the title-deeds of many valuable grants of land to the monasteries are headed by such preambles, composed by the testators about the period when the good King Roger was expelling the Saracens from that island.

42 In Sicily, especially, the title deeds for many significant land grants to the monasteries begin with such introductions written by the testators around the time when the good King Roger was driving the Saracens out of that island.

43 De Fossilib. pp. 109, 176.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Fossil Studies. pp. 109, 176.

44 Aristotle, On Animals, chaps. 1, 15.

44 Aristotle, On Animals, chapters 1, 15.

45 Brocchi, Con. Fos. Subap. Disc. sui Progressi. vol. i. p. 57.

45 Brocchi, Con. Fos. Subap. Disc. on Progress. vol. i. p. 57.

46 De Metallicis.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ On Metals.

47 Dies Caniculares.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Dog Days.

48 Storia Naturale.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Natural History.

49 Osserv. sugli Animali aquat. e terrest. 1626.

49 Observations on Aquatic and Terrestrial Animals 1626.

50 Sex itaque distinctas Etruriæ facies agnoscimus, dum bis fluida, bis plana, et sicca, bis aspera fuerit, &c.

50 Therefore, we recognize the distinct features of Etruria as it has been both fluid and flat, dry and rough, etc.

51 Scilla quotes the remark of Cicero on the story that a stone in Chios had been cleft open, and presented the head of Paniscus in relief:—"I believe," said the orator, "that the figure bore some resemblance to Paniscus, but not such that you would have deemed it sculptured by Scopas; for chance never perfectly imitates the truth."

51 Scilla refers to Cicero's comment about a story where a stone in Chios was split open, revealing a relief of Paniscus’s head:—"I believe," the orator said, "that the figure looked somewhat like Paniscus, but not enough that you would think it was carved by Scopas; because chance never perfectly mimics reality."

52 De Testaceis fossilibus Mus. Septaliani.

52 On Fossil Shells from the Septalian Museum.

53 The opinions of Boyle, alluded to by Quirini, were published a few years before, in a short article entitled "On the Bottom of the Sea." From observations collected from the divers of the pearl fishery, Boyle inferred that, when the waves were six or seven feet high above the surface of the water, there were no signs of agitation at the depth of fifteen fathoms; and that even during heavy gales of wind, the motion of the water was exceedingly diminished at the depth of twelve or fifteen feet. He had also learnt from some of his informants, that there were currents running in opposite directions at different depths.—Boyle's Works, vol. iii. p. 110. London, 1744.

53 The views of Boyle, mentioned by Quirini, were published a few years earlier in a brief piece titled "On the Bottom of the Sea." Based on observations gathered from pearl fishery divers, Boyle concluded that when the waves were six or seven feet high above the surface, there were no signs of movement at a depth of fifteen fathoms; and that even during strong windstorms, the water's motion was significantly reduced at depths of twelve or fifteen feet. He also learned from some of his sources that there were currents flowing in opposite directions at different depths.—Boyle's Works, vol. iii. p. 110. London, 1744.

54 See Conybeare and Phillips, "Outlines of the Geology of England and Wales," p. 12.

54 See Conybeare and Phillips, "Outlines of the Geology of England and Wales," p. 12.

55 Unde jam duplex origo intelligitur primorum corporum, una, cum ab ignis fusione refrigescerent, altera, cum reconcrescerent ex solutione aquarum.

55 Now, the dual origin of the first bodies is understood: one, when they cooled after being melted by fire, and the other, when they grew back from the solution of waters.

56 Redeunte mox simili causâ strata subinde alia aliis imponerentur, et facies teneri adhuc orbis sæpius novata est. Donec quiescentibus causis, atque æquilibratis, consistentior emergeret rerum status.—For an able analysis of the views of Leibnitz, in his Protogœa, see Mr. Conybeare's Report to the Brit. Assoc. on the Progress of Geological Science, 1832.

56 Soon, layers would be laid one over the other for similar reasons, and the appearance of the still-changing world was frequently renewed. Until the underlying causes settled down and balanced out, a more stable state of affairs would emerge.—For a thorough analysis of Leibnitz's ideas in his Protogœa, see Mr. Conybeare's Report to the British Association on the Progress of Geological Science, 1832.

57 Between the year 1688 and his death, in 1703, he read several memoirs to the Royal Society, and delivered lectures on various subjects, relating to fossil remains and the effects of earthquakes.

57 Between 1688 and his death in 1703, he presented several memoirs to the Royal Society and gave lectures on different topics related to fossil remains and the impacts of earthquakes.

58 Posth. Works, Lecture, Feb. 29, 1688.

58 Posthumous Works, Lecture, February 29, 1688.

59 Posth. Works, p. 327.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Posth. Works, p. 327.

60 Posth. Works, Lecture, Feb. 15, 1688. Hooke explained with considerable clearness the different modes wherein organic substances may become lapidified; and, among other illustrations, he mentions some silicified palm-wood brought from Africa, on which M. de la Hire had read a memoir to the Royal Academy of France (June, 1692), wherein he had pointed out, not only the tubes running the length of the trunk, but the roots at one extremity. De la Hire, says Hooke, also treated of certain trees found petrified in the "river that passes by Bakan, in the kingdom of Ava, and which has for the space of ten leagues the virtue of petrifying wood." It is an interesting fact that the silicified wood of the Irawadi should have attracted attention more than one hundred years ago. Remarkable discoveries have been made there in later times of fossil animals and vegetables, by Mr. Crawfurd and Dr. Wallich.—See Geol. Trans. vol. ii. part iii. p. 377, second series. De la Hire cites Father Duchatz, in the second volume of "Observations made in the Indies by the Jesuits."

60 Posth. Works, Lecture, Feb. 15, 1688. Hooke clearly explained the different ways organic substances can become stone-like; and, among various examples, he mentioned some silicified palm wood brought from Africa, on which M. de la Hire had presented a paper to the Royal Academy of France (June, 1692). In that paper, he pointed out not only the tubes running along the trunk but also the roots at one end. Hooke notes that De la Hire also discussed certain trees found petrified in the "river that flows by Bakan, in the kingdom of Ava, which has the ability to petrify wood for ten leagues." It's interesting that the silicified wood from the Irawadi caught attention over a hundred years ago. Significant discoveries of fossilized animals and plants have been made there more recently by Mr. Crawfurd and Dr. Wallich.—See Geol. Trans. vol. ii. part iii. p. 377, second series. De la Hire cites Father Duchatz in the second volume of "Observations made in the Indies by the Jesuits."

61 Posth. Works, Lecture, May 29, 1689.

61 Posth. Works, Lecture, May 29, 1689.

62 Posth. Works, p. 312.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Published Works, p. 312.

63 Posth. Works, p. 410.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Posthumous Works, p. 410.

64 Ray's Physico-theological Discourses were of somewhat later date than Hooke's great work on earthquakes. He speaks of Hooke as one "whom for his learning and deep insight into the mysteries of nature he deservedly honored."—On the Deluge, chap. iv.

64 Ray's Physico-theological Discourses were published a bit later than Hooke's major work on earthquakes. He refers to Hooke as someone "who, because of his knowledge and profound understanding of the mysteries of nature, is justly respected."—On the Deluge, chap. iv.

65 Essay towards a Natural History of the Earth, 1695. Preface.

65 Essay towards a Natural History of the Earth, 1695. Preface.

66 Ibid.

Ibid.

67 Consequences of the Deluge, p. 165.

67 Effects of the Flood, p. 165.

68 First published in Latin between the years 1680 and 1690.

68 First published in Latin from 1680 to 1690.

69 An Examination of Dr. Burnet's Theory, &c., 2d ed. 1734.

69 An Examination of Dr. Burnet's Theory, etc., 2nd ed. 1734.

70 Ramazzini even asserted, that the ideas of Burnet were mainly borrowed from a dialogue of one Patrizio; but Brocchi, after reading that dialogue, assures us that there was scarcely any other correspondence between these systems, except that both were equally whimsical.

70 Ramazzini even claimed that Burnet's ideas were mostly taken from a dialogue by someone named Patrizio; however, Brocchi, after reading that dialogue, tells us that there was hardly any other connection between these systems, except that both were equally fanciful.

71 Dei Corpi Marini, Lettere critiche, &c. 1721.

71 Of Marine Bodies, Critical Letters, &c. 1721.

72 Brocchi, p. 28.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Brocchi, p. 28.

73 Ibid. p. 33.

Ibid. p. 33.

74 Ibid.

Ibid.

75 Sui Crostacei ed altri Corpi Marini che si trovano sui Monti.

75 The Crustaceans and other Marine Bodies found on the Mountains.

76 Moro does not cite the works of Hooke and Ray; and although so many of his views were in accordance with theirs, he was probably ignorant of their wrItings, for they had not been translated. As he always refers to the Latin edition of Burnet, and a French translation of Woodward, we may presume that he did not read English.

76 Moro doesn't mention the works of Hooke and Ray; and although many of his ideas aligned with theirs, he likely wasn't aware of their writings since they hadn't been translated. Since he consistently refers to the Latin edition of Burnet and a French translation of Woodward, we can assume that he didn't read English.

77 Saggio fisico intorno alla Storia del Mare, part i. p. 24.

77 Physical Essay on the History of the Sea, part i. p. 24.

78 "Abbomino al sommo qualsivoglia sistema, che sia di pianta fabbricato in aria; massime quando è tale, che non possa sostenersi senza un miracolo," &c.—De' Crostacei e di altre Produz. del Mare, &c. 1749.

78 "I hate any system that is built in the air, especially when it can't stand on its own without a miracle," &c.—On Crustaceans and Other Products of the Sea, &c. 1749.

79 "Senza violenze, senza finzioni, senza supposti, senza miracoli." De' Crostacei e di altre Produz. del Mare, &c. 1749.

79 "Without violence, without pretenses, without assumptions, without miracles." De' Crostacei e di altre Produz. del Mare, &c. 1749.

80 Sui Testacei della Sicilia.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Sui Testacei della Sicilia.

81 Hist. Nat. tom. v. éd. de l'Imp. Royale, Paris, 1769.

81 Hist. Nat. Vol. v, Imperial Edition, Paris, 1769.

82 Essai d'une Hist. Nat. des Couches de la Terre, 1759.

82 Essay on a Natural History of the Earth's Layers, 1759.

83 John Gesner published at Leyden, in Latin.

83 John Gesner published in Leiden, in Latin.

84 Part ii. chap. 9.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Part 2, chapter 9.

85 Giornale del Criselini, 1759.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Criselini Journal, 1759.

86 See a sketch of the History of English Geology, by Dr. Fitton, in Edinb. Rev. Feb. 1818, re-edited Lond. and Edinb. Phil. Mag. vols. i. and ii. 1832-3. Some of Michell's observations anticipate in so remarkable a manner the theories established forty years afterwards, that his writings would probably have formed an era in the science, if his researches had been uninterrupted. He held, however, his professorship only eight years, when his career was suddenly cut short by preferment to a benefice. From that time he appears to have been engaged in his clerical duties, and to have entirely discontinued his scientific pursuits, exemplifying the working of a system still in force at Oxford and Cambridge, where the chairs of mathematics, natural philosophy, chemistry, botany, astronomy, geology, mineralogy, and others, being frequently filled by clergymen, the reward of success disqualifies them, if they conscientiously discharge their new duties, from farther advancing the cause of science, and that, too, at the moment when their labors would naturally bear the richest fruits.

86 Check out a sketch of the History of English Geology by Dr. Fitton, published in Edinb. Rev. Feb. 1818, reissued in Lond. and Edinb. Phil. Mag. vols. i. and ii. 1832-3. Some of Michell's observations are so remarkably ahead of their time that if his research hadn't been interrupted, his writings could have marked a significant turning point in the field. However, he only held his professorship for eight years before his career was abruptly ended due to a promotion to a church position. After that, he seems to have focused entirely on his clerical duties and completely stopped his scientific work, illustrating how a system still in place at Oxford and Cambridge functions. There, positions in mathematics, natural philosophy, chemistry, botany, astronomy, geology, mineralogy, and others are often held by clergymen. Their success in these roles often prevents them from furthering scientific work if they responsibly fulfill their new obligations, especially at a time when their efforts could produce the most significant results.

87 Sui Corpi Marini del Feltrino, 1761.

87 Sui Corpi Marini del Feltrino, 1761.

88 De Novis e Mari Natis Insulis. Raspe was also the editor of the "Philosophical Works of Leibnitz. Amst. et Leipzig, 1765;" also author of "Tassie's Gems," and "Baron Munchausen's Travels."

88 De Novis e Mari Natis Insulis. Raspe was also the editor of the "Philosophical Works of Leibnitz. Amsterdam and Leipzig, 1765;" and he also wrote "Tassie's Gems" and "Baron Munchausen's Travels."

89 Acta Academiæ Electoralis Maguntinæ, vol. ii. Erfurt.

89 Proceedings of the Electoral Academy of Mainz, vol. ii. Erfurt.

90 This account of Fuchsel is derived from an excellent analysis of his memoirs by M. Keferstein. Journ. de Géologie, tom. ii. Oct. 1830.

90 This account of Fuchsel comes from a great analysis of his memoirs by M. Keferstein. Journ. de Géologie, vol. ii. Oct. 1830.

91 Saggio orittografico, &c. 1780, and other Works.

91 Essay on Ornithography, etc. 1780, and other Works.

92 Lett. sui Pesci Fossili di Bolca. Milan, 1793.

92 Letter on the Fossil Fish of Bolca. Milan, 1793.

93 This argument of Testa has been strengthened of late years by the discovery that dealers in shells had long been in the habit of selling Mediterranean species as shells of more southern and distant latitudes, for the sake of enhancing their price. It appears, moreover, from several hundred experiments made by that distinguished hydrographer, Capt. Smith, on the water within eight fathoms of the surface, that the temperature of the Mediterranean is on an average 3½° of Fahrenheit higher than the western part of the Atlantic ocean; an important fact, which in some degree may help to explain why many species are common to tropical latitudes and to the Mediterranean.

93 Recently, Testa's argument has been supported by the finding that shell dealers have been selling Mediterranean species as if they were from more southern and remote locations, just to boost their prices. Additionally, several hundred experiments conducted by the renowned hydrographer, Capt. Smith, on the water within eight fathoms of the surface, show that the temperature of the Mediterranean is, on average, 3½° Fahrenheit higher than that of the western part of the Atlantic Ocean. This is an important detail that may help explain why many species are found both in tropical areas and in the Mediterranean.

94 Inquiry into the Original State and Formation of the Earth, 1778.

94 Investigation into the Earth's Original Condition and Development, 1778.

95 Observ. on the Formation of Mountains. Act Petrop. ann. 1778, part i.

95 Observ. on the Formation of Mountains. Act Petrop. ann. 1778, part i.

96 Nov. comm. Petr. XVII. Cuvier, Eloge de Pallas.

96 Nov. comm. Petr. XVII. Cuvier, Eloge de Pallas.

97 Cuvier, Eloge de Werner.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Cuvier, Tribute to Werner.

98 I am indebted for this information partly to Messrs. Sedgwick and Murchison, who have investigated the country, and partly to Dr. Charles Hartmann, the translator of this work into German.

98 I owe this information to Messrs. Sedgwick and Murchison, who have studied the country, and also to Dr. Charles Hartmann, the translator of this work into German.

99 Cuvier, Eloge de Desmarest.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Cuvier, Tribute to Desmarest.

100 Journ. de Phys. vol. xiii. p. 115; and Mém. de l'Inst., Sciences Mathémat. et Phys. vol. vi. p. 219.

100 Journ. de Phys. vol. 13, p. 115; and Mém. de l'Inst., Sciences Mathémat. et Phys. vol. 6, p. 219.

101 Journ. de Phys. tom. xxxv. p. 191.

101 Journ. de Phys. vol. 35, p. 191.

102 Ib. tom. xxxvii. part ii. p. 200.

102 Ib. vol. 37, part 2, p. 200.

103 Cuvier, Eloge de Desmarest.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Cuvier, Tribute to Desmarest.

104 Ed. Phil. Trans. 1788.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Phil. Trans. 1788.

105 Playfair's Works, vol. iv. p. 75.

105 Playfair's Works, vol. 4, p. 75.

106 "Before me things create were none, save things Eternal."—Dante's Inferno, canto iii. Cary's Translation.

106 "Before me, nothing was created, except for eternal things."—Dante's Inferno, canto iii. Cary's Translation.

107 Playfair's Works, vol. iv. p. 55.

107 Playfair's Works, vol. iv. p. 55.

108 In allusion to the theories of Burnet, Woodward, and other physico-theological writers, he declared that they were as fond of changes of scene on the face of the globe, as were the populace at a play. "Every one of them destroys and renovates the earth after his own fashion, as Descartes framed it: for philosophers put themselves without ceremony in the place of God, and think to create a universe with a word."—Dissertation envoyée a l'Academie de Boulogne, sur les Changemens arrivés dans notre Globe. Unfortunately, this and similar ridicule directed against the cosmogonists was too well deserved.

108 Referring to the ideas of Burnet, Woodward, and other writers focused on the relationship between science and theology, he said they were just as interested in changes on the surface of the Earth as the audience is during a play. "Each one of them destroys and revives the planet in their own way, just as Descartes envisioned it: philosophers unceremoniously place themselves in God's position and believe they can create a universe with just a word."—Dissertation envoyée a l'Academie de Boulogne, sur les Changemens arrivés dans notre Globe. Unfortunately, this and similar mockery aimed at the cosmogonists was well deserved.

109 See the chapter on "Des Pierres figurés."

109 Check out the chapter on "Des Pierres figurés."

110 In that essay he lays it down, "that all naturalists are now agreed that deposits of shells in the midst of the continents are monuments of the continued occupation of these districts by the ocean." In another place also, when speaking of the fossil shells of Touraine, he admits their true origin.

110 In that essay he states, "that all naturalists now agree that shell deposits in the middle of continents are evidence of the ocean's ongoing presence in these areas." Elsewhere, when discussing the fossil shells of Touraine, he acknowledges their actual origin.

111 As an instance of his desire to throw doubt indiscriminately on all geological data, we may recall the passage where he says, that "the bones of a reindeer and hippopotamus discovered near Etempes did not prove, as some would have it, that Lapland and the Nile were once on a tour from Paris to Orleans, but merely that a lover of curiosities once preserved them in his cabinet."

111 For an example of his tendency to cast doubt on all geological data, we can look at the part where he says that "the bones of a reindeer and hippopotamus found near Etempes don’t prove, as some claim, that Lapland and the Nile were once on a trip from Paris to Orleans, but only that someone who collected curiosities once kept them in his cabinet."

Some drill and bore The solid ground, and from the layers there Get a record that helps us learn. That he who created it and shared its date "Moses was wrong about its age." The Task, Book III. "The Garden."

113 P. 577.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ p. 577.

114 P. 59.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ p. 59.

115 Introd. p. 2.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Intro p. 2.

116 London, 1809.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ London, 1809.

117 In a most able article, by Mr. Drinkwater, on the "Life of Galileo," published in the "Library of Useful Knowledge," it is stated that both Galileo's work, and the book of Copernicus, "Nisi corrigatur" (for, with the omission of certain passages, it was sanctioned), were still to be seen on the forbidden list of the Index at Rome, in 1828. I was, however, assured in the same year, by Professor Scarpellini, at Rome, that Pius VII., a pontiff distinguished for his love of science, had procured a repeal of the edicts against Galileo and the Copernican system. He had assembled the Congregation; and the late Cardinal Toriozzi, assessor of the Sacred Office, proposed that they should wipe off this scandal from the church." The repeal was carried, with the dissentient voice of one Dominican only. Long before that time the Newtonian theory had been taught in the Sapienza, and all Catholic universities in Europe (with the exception, I am told, of Salamanca); but it was always required of professors, in deference to the decrees of the church, to use the term hypothesis, instead of theory. They now speak of the Copernican theory.

117 In a very insightful article by Mr. Drinkwater about the "Life of Galileo," published in the "Library of Useful Knowledge," it’s mentioned that both Galileo's work and Copernicus's book "Nisi corrigatur" (which was approved with some passages omitted) were still on the forbidden list of the Index in Rome in 1828. However, in the same year, Professor Scarpellini assured me in Rome that Pius VII., a pope known for his appreciation of science, had successfully repealed the edicts against Galileo and the Copernican system. He convened the Congregation, and the late Cardinal Toriozzi, an advisor to the Sacred Office, suggested they remove this scandal from the church. The repeal was approved, with only one Dominican opposing it. Long before this, the Newtonian theory had been taught at Sapienza and all Catholic universities in Europe (except, I’m told, Salamanca); however, professors were always required to use the term hypothesis instead of theory, out of respect for the church’s decrees. Now, they refer to the Copernican theory.

118 Elementary Treatise on Geology. London, 1809. Translated by De la Fite.

118 Basic Guide to Geology. London, 1809. Translated by De la Fite.

119 See Dr. Fitton's Memoir, before cited, p. 57.

119 See Dr. Fitton's Memoir, previously mentioned, p. 57.

120 Whewell, British Critic, No. xvii. p. 187, 1831.

120 Whewell, British Critic, No. xvii. p. 187, 1831.

121 Discours sur les Révol. &c.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Discussion on the Revolutions, etc.

122 Niebuhr's Hist. of Rome, vol. i. p. 5. Hare and Thirlwall's translation.

122 Niebuhr's History of Rome, volume 1, page 5. Translation by Hare and Thirlwall.

123 Gibbon, Decline and Fall, chap. xxxiii.

123 Gibbon, Decline and Fall, chap. xxxiii.

124 Id. Ibid.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Id. Ibid.

125 In the earlier editions of this work, a fourth book was added on Geology Proper, or Systematic Geology, containing an account of the former changes of the animate and inanimate creation, brought to light by an examination of the crust of the earth. This I afterwards (in 1838) expanded into a separate publication called the Elements of Manual Geology, of which a fourth edition appeared December, 1851.

125 In the earlier versions of this work, a fourth book was included on Geology Proper, or Systematic Geology, which detailed the past changes of living and non-living creation, revealed through an analysis of the Earth's crust. Later on (in 1838), I expanded this into a standalone publication titled the Elements of Manual Geology, with a fourth edition released in December 1851.

126 See two articles by the Rev. Dr. Fleming, in the Edinburgh New Phil. Journ. No. xii. p. 277, April, 1829; and No. xv. p. 65, Jan. 1830.

126 Check out two articles by Rev. Dr. Fleming in the Edinburgh New Phil. Journ. No. 12, p. 277, April 1829; and No. 15, p. 65, January 1830.

127 Book iii. chaps. 46, 47, &c.

127 Book iii. chaps. 46, 47, &c.

128 Macacus pliocenus, Owen, Brit. Foss. Mam. Intr. p. 37, found with the extinct elephant, &c. in the modern freshwater beds at Grays Thurrock (Essex), in the valley of the Thames.

128 Macacus pliocenus, Owen, Brit. Foss. Mam. Intr. p. 37, found alongside the extinct elephant, etc., in the current freshwater deposits at Grays Thurrock (Essex), in the Thames valley.

129 Geol. Proceedings, No. xxxvi. June, 1834.

129 Geological Proceedings, No. 36. June, 1834.

130 Phil. Mag., Sept. 1829, and Jan. 1830.

130 Phil. Mag., Sept. 1829, and Jan. 1830.

131 Fleming, Ed. New Phil. Journ., No. xii. p. 282, 1829. The zebra, however, inhabits chiefly the extra-tropical parts of Africa.

131 Fleming, Ed. New Phil. Journ., No. xii. p. 282, 1829. The zebra primarily lives in the non-tropical regions of Africa.

132 Humboldt, Fragmens de Géologie, &c., tome ii. p. 388. Ehrenberg, Ann. des Sci. Nat., tome xxi. p. 387.

132 Humboldt, Fragments of Geology, &c., vol. ii, p. 388. Ehrenberg, Annals of Natural Sciences, vol. xxi, p. 387.

133 Ehrenberg, ibid. p. 390.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Ehrenberg, same source, p. 390.

134 Journ. of Asiat. Soc., vol. i. p. 240.

134 Journal of the Asiatic Society, vol. 1, p. 240.

135 Rafinesque, Atlantic Journ., p. 18.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Rafinesque, Atlantic Journal, p. 18.

136 Darwin's Journal of Travels in South America, &c., 1832 to 1836, in Voyage of H. M. S. Beagle, p. 159.

136 Darwin's Journal of Travels in South America, etc., 1832 to 1836, in Voyage of H. M. S. Beagle, p. 159.

137 Ehrenberg, ibid.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Ehrenberg, same source.

138 The speculations which follow, on the ancient physical geography of Siberia, and its former fitness as a residence for the mammoth, were first given in their present form in my 4th edition, June, 1835. Recently Sir R. Murchison and his companions in their great work on the Geology of Russia, 1845 (vol. i. p. 497), have, in citing this chapter, declared that their investigations have led them to similar conclusions. Professor Owen, in his excellent History of British Fossil Mammalia, 1844, p. 261, et seq., observes that the teeth of the mammoth differ from those of the living Asiatic or African elephant in having a larger proportion of dense enamel, which may have enabled it to subsist on the coarser ligneous tissues of trees and shrubs. In short, he is of opinion, that the structure of its teeth, as well as the nature of its epidermis and coverings, may have made it "a meet companion for the reindeer."

138 The ideas that follow about the ancient physical geography of Siberia and its past suitability as a home for the mammoth were first presented in this form in my 4th edition, June 1835. Recently, Sir R. Murchison and his colleagues, in their significant work on the Geology of Russia, 1845 (vol. i. p. 497), have noted that their research has led them to similar conclusions. Professor Owen, in his outstanding History of British Fossil Mammalia, 1844, p. 261, et seq., points out that the teeth of the mammoth differ from those of today's Asian or African elephants due to having a larger proportion of dense enamel, which may have allowed it to feed on the tougher woody tissues of trees and shrubs. In short, he believes that the structure of its teeth, along with the nature of its skin and coverings, may have made it "a suitable companion for the reindeer."

139 Pallas, Reise in Russ. Reiche, pp. 409, 410.

139 Pallas, Travel in the Russian Empire, pp. 409, 410.

140 Nov. Com. Petrop. vol. xvii. p. 584.

140 Nov. Com. Petrop. vol. xvii. p. 584.

141 Nov. Com. Petrop. vol. xvii. p. 591.

141 Nov. Com. Petrop. vol. xvii. p. 591.

142 Quart. Journ. Geol. Soc. Lond. vol. iv. p. 10, Memoirs.

142 Quarterly Journal of the Geological Society of London, vol. 4, p. 10, Memoirs.

143 Journal du Nord, St. Petersburg, 1807.

143 Journal of the North, St. Petersburg, 1807.

144 Fleming, Ed. New Phil. Journ., No. xii. p. 285.

144 Fleming, Ed. New Phil. Journ., No. 12. p. 285.

Bishop Heber informs us (Narr. of a Journey through the Upper Provinces of India, vol. ii. p. 166-219), that in the lower range of the Himalaya mountains, in the northeastern borders of the Delhi territory, between lat. 29° and 30°, he saw an Indian elephant of a small size, covered with shaggy hair. But this variety must be exceedingly rare; for Mr. Royle (late superintendent of the East India Company's Botanic Garden at Saharunpore) has assured me, that being in India when Heber's Journal appeared, and having never seen or heard of such elephants, he made the strictest inquiries respecting the fact, and was never able to obtain any evidence in corroboration. Mr. Royle resided at Saharunpore, lat. 30° N., upon the extreme northern limits of the range of the elephant. Mr. Everest also declares that he has been equally unsuccessful in finding any one aware of the existence of such a variety or breed of the animal, though one solitary individual was mentioned to him as having been seen at Delhi, with a good deal of long hair upon it. The greatest elevation, says Mr. E., at which the wild elephant is found in the mountains to the north of Bengal, is at a place called Nahun, about 4000 feet above the level of the sea, and in the 31st degree of N. lat., where the mean yearly temperature may be about 64° Fahrenheit, and the difference between winter and summer very great, equal to about 36° F., the month of January averaging 45°, and June, the hottest month, 81° F. (Everest on climate of Foss. Eleph., Journ. of Asiat. Soc., No. 25, p. 21.)

Bishop Heber tells us (Narr. of a Journey through the Upper Provinces of India, vol. ii. p. 166-219) that in the lower range of the Himalayan mountains, on the northeastern borders of the Delhi territory, between lat. 29° and 30°, he observed a small Indian elephant covered in shaggy hair. However, this variety must be incredibly rare; Mr. Royle (former superintendent of the East India Company's Botanic Garden at Saharunpore) told me that while in India when Heber's Journal was published, he had never seen or heard of such elephants. He made the strictest inquiries about the matter and was unable to find any supporting evidence. Mr. Royle lived in Saharunpore, lat. 30° N., at the extreme northern limits of the elephant's range. Mr. Everest also stated that he had been equally unsuccessful in finding anyone who knew about this variety or breed of the animal, although he was informed about one solitary individual said to have been seen in Delhi, which had quite a bit of long hair. The highest elevation at which wild elephants are found in the mountains north of Bengal, according to Mr. E., is a place called Nahun, about 4000 feet above sea level, and in the 31st degree of N. lat., where the average yearly temperature is around 64° Fahrenheit, with a significant difference between winter and summer, about 36° F., with January averaging 45° and June, the hottest month, at 81° F. (Everest on climate of Foss. Eleph., Journ. of Asiat. Soc., No. 25, p. 21.)

145 See Dr. Buckland's description of these bones, Appen. to Beechy's Voy.

145 See Dr. Buckland's description of these bones, Appendix to Beechy's Voyage.

146 Darwin, Journal of Travels in S. America, &c., 1832-36, in voyage of H. M. S. Beagle, p. 98. 2d Ed. London, 1845, p. 86.

146 Darwin, Journal of Travels in South America, etc., 1832-36, during the voyage of H.M.S. Beagle, p. 98. 2nd Ed. London, 1845, p. 86.

147 Darwin, Journal of Travels in S. America, &c., p. 99, 2d Ed. p. 85.

147 Darwin, Journal of Travels in South America, etc., p. 99, 2nd Ed. p. 85.

148 Burchell, cited by Darwin, ibid. p. 101. 2d Ed. p. 87.

148 Burchell, mentioned by Darwin, same source, p. 101. 2nd Ed. p. 87.

149 Since the above passage was first printed in a former edition, June, 1835, it has been shown by the observations of Sir R. Murchison, M. de Verneuil, and Count Keyserling, and more recently by M. Middendorf (see above, p. 81), that the Lowland of Siberia has actually been extended, since the existing species of shells inhabited the northern seas.

149 Since the passage above was first published in an earlier edition in June 1835, it has been demonstrated by the observations of Sir R. Murchison, M. de Verneuil, and Count Keyserling, and more recently by M. Middendorf (see above, p. 81), that the Lowland of Siberia has actually expanded, since the current species of shells live in the northern seas.

150 Humboldt, Fragmens Asiatiques, tom. ii. p. 393.

150 Humboldt, Asian Fragments, vol. ii. p. 393.

151 Reboul. Geol. de la Période Quaternaire, who cites Observ. sur la Sibérie, Bibl. Univ., Juillet, 1832.

151 Reboul. Geology of the Quaternary Period, which mentions Observations on Siberia, Universal Library, July, 1832.

152 Conjectured to be the wild stock of Bos grunniens.

152 Thought to be the wild ancestor of Bos grunniens.

153 Recollections of a Journey through Tartary, Thibet, and China (ch. xv. p. 234), by M. Huc. Longman, 1852.

153 Memories of a Journey through Tartary, Tibet, and China (ch. xv. p. 234), by M. Huc. Longman, 1852.

154 For an account of the more modern changes of the tertiary fauna and flora of the British Isles and adjoining countries, and particularly those facts which relate to the "glacial epoch," see an admirable essay by Prof. E. Forbes. Memoirs of Geol. Survey of Great Brit. vol. i. p. 336. London, 1846. To this important memoir I shall have frequent occasion to refer in the sequel.

154 For information on the more recent changes in the plants and animals of the British Isles and nearby regions, especially those related to the "glacial epoch," check out an excellent essay by Prof. E. Forbes. Memoirs of Geol. Survey of Great Brit. vol. i. p. 336. London, 1846. I'll refer back to this important memoir often in the following sections.

155 See a paper by Charles J. F. Bunbury, Esq., Journ. of Geol. Soc., London, No. 6, p. 88. 1846.

155 Check out a paper by Charles J. F. Bunbury, Esq., Journ. of Geol. Soc., London, No. 6, p. 88. 1846.

156 The Calamites were formerly regarded by Adolphe Brongniart as belonging to the tribe of Equisetaceæ; but he is now inclined to refer them to the class of gymnogens, or gymnospermous exogens, which includes the Coniferæ and Cycadeæ. Lepidodendron appears to have been either a gigantic form of the lycopodium tribe, or, as Dr. Lindley thinks, intermediate between the lycopodia and the fir tribe. The Sigillariæ were formerly supposed by Ad. Brongniart, to be arborescent ferns; but the discovery of their internal structure, and of their leaves, has since proved that they have no real affinity to ferns. According to the view now taken of their structure, their nearest allies in the recent world are the genera Cycas and Zamia; while Corda, on the other hand, maintains that they were closely related to the succulent euphorbias. Stigmaria is now generally admitted to have been merely the root of sigillaria. The scalariform vessels of these two genera are not conclusive in proving them to have a real affinity with ferns, as Mr. Brown has discovered the same structure of vessels in Myzodendron, a genus allied to the mistletoe; and Corda has lately shown that in two species of Stigmaria, hardly distinguishable by external characters, the vessels of the one are scalariform, and of the other dotted.

156 Calamites used to be classified by Adolphe Brongniart as part of the Equisetaceæ family; however, he now leans towards placing them in the gymnogens class, or gymnospermous exogens, which includes Coniferæ and Cycadeæ. Lepidodendron seems to have been a large version of the lycopodium group, or, as Dr. Lindley suggests, somewhat between lycopodia and the fir family. Sigillariæ were previously thought by Ad. Brongniart to be tree ferns, but the discovery of their internal structure and leaves has shown that they aren't actually related to ferns at all. Based on the current understanding of their structure, their closest relatives today are the genera Cycas and Zamia; meanwhile, Corda argues they were more closely linked to succulent euphorbias. It’s now widely accepted that Stigmaria was just the root of sigillaria. The scalariform vessels in these two groups don’t definitively prove a relationship to ferns, as Mr. Brown has found the same type of vessels in Myzodendron, which is related to mistletoe; and Corda has recently demonstrated that in two species of Stigmaria, which are barely distinguishable from each other externally, one has scalariform vessels while the other has dotted vessels.

157 Mr. Lindley endeavored formerly (1834) to show, in the "Fossil Flora," that Trigonocarpum Noeggerathii, a fruit found in the coal measures, has the true structure of a palm-fruit; but Ad. Brongniart has since inclined to regard it as cycadeous; nor is the French botanist satisfied that some specimens of supposed palm wood from the coal-mines of Radnitz in Bohemia, described by Corda, really belong to palms. On the other hand, Corda has proved Flabellaria borassifolia of Sternberg to be an exogenous plant, and Brongniart contends that it was allied to the Cycadeæ. See Tableau des Genres de Végétaux Fossiles. Paris, 1849.

157 Mr. Lindley previously (1834) attempted to demonstrate, in the "Fossil Flora," that Trigonocarpum Noeggerathii, a fruit discovered in the coal measures, actually has the structure of a palm fruit; however, Ad. Brongniart has since leaned toward viewing it as cycadeous. The French botanist is also not convinced that some specimens of what were thought to be palm wood from the coal mines of Radnitz in Bohemia, described by Corda, truly belong to palms. Conversely, Corda has established that Flabellaria borassifolia of Sternberg is an exogenous plant, while Brongniart argues that it is related to the Cycadeæ. See Tableau des Genres de Végétaux Fossiles. Paris, 1849.

158 Prodrome d'une Hist. des Végét. Foss. p. 179. See also a late paper, Quart. Journ. of Geol. Soc. London, 1846, in which coal-plants of Alabama, lat. 33° N., collected by the author, are identified by Mr. Bunbury with British fossil species, showing the great southern extension of this flora.

158 Prodrome of a History of Fossil Vegetation p. 179. See also a recent paper, Quart. Journ. of Geol. Soc. London, 1846, where Mr. Bunbury identifies coal plants from Alabama, lat. 33° N., collected by the author, with British fossil species, demonstrating the significant southern spread of this flora.

159 König, Journ. of Sci., vol. xv. p. 20. Mr. König informs me that he no longer believes any of these fossils to be tree ferns, as he at first stated, but that they agree generically with plants in our English coal-beds. The Melville Island specimens, now in the British Museum, are very obscure impressions.

159 König, Journ. of Sci., vol. xv. p. 20. Mr. König tells me that he no longer thinks any of these fossils are tree ferns, as he initially claimed, but that they are more similar generically to plants found in our English coal-beds. The Melville Island specimens, currently in the British Museum, are very unclear impressions.

160 Fossil Flora of Great Britain, by John Lindley and William Hutton, Esqrs., No. IV.

160 Fossil Flora of Great Britain, by John Lindley and William Hutton, Esquires, No. IV.

161 Fossil Flora of Great Britain, by John Lindley and William Hutton, Esqrs. No. IV.

161 Fossil Flora of Great Britain, by John Lindley and William Hutton, Esqrs. No. IV.

162 Fossil Flora, No. X.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Fossil Plants, No. X.

163 This has been proved by Mr. Lindley's experiments, ibid. No. XVII.

163 This has been demonstrated by Mr. Lindley's experiments, ibid. No. XVII.

164 I have treated of this subject in my Manual of Geology, and still more fully in my Travels in N. America, vol. ii. p. 178. For a full account of the facts at present known, and the theories entertained by the most eminent geologists and botanists on this subject, see Mr. Horner's Anniversary Address to the Geological Society of London, February, 1846. Consult also Sir H. de la Beche, on the formation of rocks in South Wales, Memoirs of Geol. Survey of Great Britain, 1846, p. 1 to 296.

164 I've discussed this topic in my Manual of Geology, and even more extensively in my Travels in N. America, vol. ii. p. 178. For a complete overview of the currently known facts and the theories held by leading geologists and botanists on this subject, check out Mr. Horner's Anniversary Address to the Geological Society of London, February, 1846. Also, refer to Sir H. de la Beche's work on the formation of rocks in South Wales, Memoirs of Geol. Survey of Great Britain, 1846, p. 1 to 296.

165 The theory proposed in this and the following chapters, to account for former fluctuations of climate at successive geological periods, agrees in every essential particular, and has indeed been reprinted almost verbatim from that published by me twenty years ago in the first edition of my Principles, 1830. It was referred to by Sir John F. W. Herschel in his Discourse on Natural Philosophy, published in 1830. In preceding works the gradual diminution of the earth's central heat was almost the only cause assigned for the acknowledged diminution of the superficial temperature of our planet.

165 The theory presented in this and the following chapters, which explains past climate fluctuations during different geological periods, aligns perfectly in every key aspect with what I published twenty years ago in the first edition of my Principles, 1830. Sir John F. W. Herschel mentioned it in his Discourse on Natural Philosophy, also published in 1830. In earlier works, the gradual decrease of the earth's central heat was primarily cited as the cause for the recognized drop in the planet's surface temperature.

166 We are indebted to Baron Alex. von Humboldt for having first collected together the scattered data on which he founded an approximation to a true theory of the distribution of heat over the globe. Many of these data were derived from the author's own observations, and many from the works of M. Pierre Prevost, of Genera, on the radiation of heat, and from other writers.—See Humboldt on Isothermal Lines, Mémoires d'Arcueil, tom. iii. translated in the Edin. Phil. Journ. vol. iii. July, 1820.

166 We owe a debt of gratitude to Baron Alex. von Humboldt for being the first to gather the scattered information that formed the basis of a more accurate theory about how heat is distributed across the globe. A lot of this information came from the author's own observations, as well as from the works of M. Pierre Prevost from Geneva on heat radiation, and other writers.—See Humboldt on Isothermal Lines, Mémoires d'Arcueil, vol. iii, translated in the Edin. Phil. Journ. vol. iii, July, 1820.

The map of Isothermal Lines, recently published by Humboldt and Dove (1848), supplies a large body of well-established data for such investigations, of which Mr. Hopkins has most ably availed himself in an essay "On the Causes which may have produced Changes in the earth's Superficial Temperature."—Q. Journ. Geol. Soc. 1852, p. 56.

The map of Isothermal Lines, recently released by Humboldt and Dove (1848), provides a significant amount of reliable data for such studies, which Mr. Hopkins has skillfully used in his essay "On the Causes which May Have Produced Changes in the Earth's Surface Temperature." —Q. Journ. Geol. Soc. 1852, p. 56.

167 Sir J. Richardson's Appendix to Sir G. Bach's Journal, 1843-1845, p. 478.

167 Sir J. Richardson's Appendix to Sir G. Bach's Journal, 1843-1845, p. 478.

168 Malte-Brun, Phys. Geol. book xvii.

Malte-Brun, Physical Geology, vol. 17.

169 On Isothermal Lines, &c.

On Isothermal Lines, etc.

170 Rennell on Currents, p. 96. London, 1832.

170 Rennell on Currents, p. 96. London, 1832.

171 Ibid. p. 153.

Ibid. p. 153.

172 Ibid. p. 25

Ibid. p. 25

173 Scoresby's Arctic Regions, vol. i. p. 208.—Dr. Latta's Observations on the Glaciers of Spitzbergen, &c. Edin. New Phil. Journ. vol. iii. p. 97.

173 Scoresby's Arctic Regions, vol. i. p. 208.—Dr. Latta's Observations on the Glaciers of Spitzbergen, &c. Edin. New Phil. Journ. vol. iii. p. 97.

174 Rennell on Currents, p. 95.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Rennell on Currents, p. 95.

175 Humboldt on Isothermal Lines.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Humboldt on Isothermal Lines.

176 Journ. of Travels in S. America, &c. p. 272.

176 Journal of Travels in South America, etc. p. 272.

177 Darwin's travels in S. America, p. 271.

177 Darwin's journeys in South America, p. 271.

178 Mr. Hopkins raises the question whether, in South Georgia, the descent of glaciers to the margin of the sea might not have been mistaken by Capt. Cook for the descent of the snow-line to the sea level. Quart. Journ. Geol. Soc. p. 85, 1852. The great navigator is generally very accurate, and there seem to be no observations of more recent date either to confirm or invalidate his statements.

178 Mr. Hopkins asks whether, in South Georgia, Capt. Cook might have confused the glaciers reaching the sea with the snow line dropping to sea level. Quart. Journ. Geol. Soc. p. 85, 1852. The great navigator is usually very precise, and there don't appear to be any more recent observations to confirm or challenge his claims.

179 After all these modern discoveries, the area still unexplored, within the antarctic circle, is more than double the area of Europe. The surface of the latter contains about 2,793,000 square geographical miles. The unexplored antarctic region, as calculated for me by Mr. Gardner, in 1840, equalled about 7,620,000 square miles.

179 Even with all these modern discoveries, the area that remains unexplored within the Antarctic Circle is more than twice the size of Europe. Europe's land area is about 2,793,000 square geographical miles. The unexplored Antarctic region, as Mr. Gardner calculated for me in 1840, is roughly 7,620,000 square miles.

180 On icebergs in low latitudes, by Capt. Horsburgh, by whom the sketch was made. Phil. Trans. 1830.

180 On icebergs in warmer regions, by Capt. Horsburgh, who created the sketch. Phil. Trans. 1830.

181 Scoresby's Arctic Regions, vol. i. p. 234.

181 Scoresby's Arctic Regions, vol. i. p. 234.

182 This follows, observes Herschel, from a very simple theorem, which may be thus stated:—"The amount of heat received by the earth from the sun, while describing any part of its orbit, is proportional to the angle described round the sun's centre." So that if the orbit be divided into two portions by a line drawn in any direction through the sun's centre, the heat received in describing the two unequal segments of the eclipse so produced will be equal. Geol. Trans. vol. iii. part. ii. p. 298; second series.

182 Herschel notes that this comes from a very simple theorem, which can be stated like this: “The amount of heat that the earth receives from the sun, while moving along any part of its orbit, is proportional to the angle covered around the sun's center.” Therefore, if the orbit is divided into two parts by a line drawn in any direction through the sun's center, the heat received while tracing the two unequal segments of the resulting eclipse will be equal. Geol. Trans. vol. iii. part. ii. p. 298; second series.

183 On Isothermal Lines.

On Isothermal Lines.

184 A full consideration of the effect of changes in physical geography on the distribution and extinction of species is given in book iii.

184 A comprehensive look at how changes in physical geography affect the distribution and extinction of species is provided in book iii.

185 For calculations founded on astronomical data, see Young's Nat. Phil., Lect. xlvii.; Mrs. Somerville's Connex. of Phys. Sci., sect. 14, p. 110. Laplace, endeavoring to estimate the probable depth of the sea from some of the phenomena of the tides, says of the ocean generally, "que sa profondeur moyenne est du même ordre que la hauteur moyenne des continens et des isles au-dessus de son niveau, hauteur qui ne surpasse pas mille mètres (3280 ft.)" Mec. Céleste, tom. xi. et Syst. du Monde, p. 254. The expression "du même ordre" admits in mathematical language of considerable latitude of signification, and does not mean that the depth of the water below the level of the sea corresponds exactly to the height of the land above it.

185 For calculations based on astronomical data, see Young's Nat. Phil., Lect. xlvii.; Mrs. Somerville's Connex. of Phys. Sci., sect. 14, p. 110. Laplace, trying to estimate the likely depth of the sea based on some tidal phenomena, states about the ocean in general, "that its average depth is of the same order as the average height of the continents and islands above its level, a height that does not exceed one thousand meters (3280 ft.)" Mec. Céleste, tom. xi. et Syst. du Monde, p. 254. The phrase "of the same order" allows for a significant range of interpretation in mathematical terms and doesn’t imply that the depth of the water below sea level exactly matches the height of the land above it.

It appeared from the observations of Sir James Ross, communicated to me in 1849, by himself, and his fellow voyager, Dr. Joseph Hooker, that in latitude 15° 3' S., longitude 23° 14' W. (the island of Trinidad, the nearest land, being 486 miles distant, and bearing S. 47 W.), they sounded with a weight of 76 lbs., and 4600 fathoms of line, which ran out to the very end, without finding bottom. Here therefore in mid-ocean the depth exceeded 27,600 feet. One of the shallowest soundings ever obtained in the open sea during the same survey, struck bottom with 2677 fathoms, or 16,062 feet, latitude 33° 21' S., longitude 9° 4' E. The surveyors arrived at the conclusion, that at a moderate distance from the shore, the depth of the great ocean always exceeds 4000 feet.

It seems from the observations of Sir James Ross, shared with me in 1849 by him and his fellow traveler, Dr. Joseph Hooker, that at latitude 15° 3' S., longitude 23° 14' W. (with the island of Trinidad, the nearest land, being 486 miles away and located at S. 47 W.), they used a weight of 76 lbs. and 4600 fathoms of line, which extended all the way without reaching the bottom. So here, in the middle of the ocean, the depth was greater than 27,600 feet. One of the shallowest measurements taken during the same survey reached the bottom at 2677 fathoms, or 16,062 feet, at latitude 33° 21' S., longitude 9° 4' E. The surveyors concluded that even at a fair distance from the shore, the depth of the vast ocean always exceeds 4000 feet.

During the American survey in 1849, a much greater depth, or 5700 fathoms (34,200 feet), was sounded in the Atlantic by Lieut. Walsh, without reaching the bottom, in lat. 31° 59' N., long. 58° 43' W., or between the Bermudas and the Azores. But the deepest soundings yet published were taken Oct. 30th 1852, by Capt. Henry M. Denham, R. N., who reached bottom at 7706 fathoms (46,236 feet), lat. 36° 49' S., long. 37° 6' W., the nearest land being at the mouth of the River Plate. A weight of 9 lbs. was attached to the line, which was one-tenth of an inch in diameter; the day was calm, and the line took 9 hours 24 minutes to run out. When the bottom was struck the line was raised 50 fathoms, and then allowed to run out again. It struck at the same point as before, verifying the observations. Nevertheless some experienced surveyors have remarked that the experiment would have been more satisfactory had the weight been greater. The highest summits of the Himalaya are about 28,000 feet; the Pacific, according to this sounding, is probably at some points twice as deep as the Himalaya are high.

During the American survey in 1849, Lieutenant Walsh recorded a much greater depth of 5,700 fathoms (34,200 feet) in the Atlantic without reaching the bottom, at latitude 31° 59' N and longitude 58° 43' W, which is located between the Bermudas and the Azores. However, the deepest measurements published so far were taken on October 30, 1852, by Captain Henry M. Denham, R.N., who reached the bottom at 7,706 fathoms (46,236 feet), at latitude 36° 49' S and longitude 37° 6' W, with the closest land being at the mouth of the River Plate. A 9-pound weight was attached to the line, which measured one-tenth of an inch in diameter. The weather was calm, and it took 9 hours and 24 minutes to let the line out. When the line hit the bottom, it was pulled up 50 fathoms and then let out again, striking the same point as before to confirm the measurements. Nevertheless, some experienced surveyors commented that the results would have been more reliable if the weight had been heavier. The highest peaks of the Himalayas are about 28,000 feet; according to this sounding, the Pacific is likely at some points twice as deep as the Himalayas are tall.

186 Mr. Hopkins, reasoning on data furnished by Dove's Isothermal maps, has arrived at the very interesting conclusion, that both on Snowdon and the lower mountains of the West of Ireland the snow-line would descend to within 1000 feet of the sea level, and glaciers reach the sea, if we could simply assume the three following geographical changes:—

186 Mr. Hopkins, based on information from Dove's Isothermal maps, has come to the fascinating conclusion that on Snowdon and the lower mountains of West Ireland, the snow line would drop to about 1000 feet above sea level, and glaciers would extend to the sea, if we could just assume the following three geographical changes:—

1st, The diversion of the Gulf stream from its present northerly course; 2dly, the depression of the existing land of Northern and Western Europe, to the amount of no more than 500 feet; and 3dly, a cold current from the North sweeping over the submerged area. Quart. Journ. Geol. Soc. 1852, p. 85.

1st, The Gulf Stream changing from its current northward direction; 2nd, the lowering of the existing land in Northern and Western Europe by up to 500 feet; and 3rd, a cold current from the North moving over the submerged area. Quart. Journ. Geol. Soc. 1852, p. 85.

187 Daniell's Meteorological Essays, p. 103.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Daniell's Weather Essays, p. 103.

188 Observed by J. Crawfurd, Esq.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Mentioned by J. Crawfurd, Esq.

189 In speaking of the circulation of air and water in this chapter, no allusion is made to the trade winds, or to irregularities in the direction of currents, caused by the rotary motion of the earth. These causes prevent the movements from being direct from north to south, or from south to north, but they do not affect the theory of a constant circulation.

189 In discussing how air and water circulate in this chapter, there’s no mention of trade winds or the irregularities in current direction caused by the Earth's rotation. These factors stop the movements from going straight from north to south or vice versa, but they don't impact the theory of a steady circulation.

190 See Scoreby's Arctic Regions, vol. i. p. 378.

190 See Scoreby's Arctic Regions, vol. i. p. 378.

191 Ibid. p. 320.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Same source, p. 320.

192 This is shown by projecting a map on the horizon of London, that is to say, by supposing the eye of the observer to be placed above that city, and to see from thence one half of the globe. For it so happens that from that point, and no other, we should behold the greatest possible quantity of land; and if we are then transferred to the opposite or antipodal point, we should see the greatest possible quantity of water. (See figs. 3 and 4.) A singular fact, first pointed out by Mr. James Gardner, namely, that only one twenty-seventh part of the dry land has any land opposite to it, is intimately connected with this excess of land in one of the two hemispheres above alluded to. Thus, in fig. 3, the land shaded black in part of China answers to that portion of the extremity of South America and Tierra del Fuego which is opposite or antipodal to it, whilst the dark spots in the northern and central parts of South America represent Borneo, Sumatra, and other antipodal islands in the Eastern Archipelago. See Gardner, Geol. Soc. Proceedings, 1833, vol. i. p. 488.

192 This is demonstrated by projecting a map onto the horizon of London, meaning that we imagine the observer's eye positioned above the city, allowing them to view one half of the globe. It turns out that from this vantage point, and no other, we would see the largest possible area of land; conversely, if we were moved to the opposite or antipodal point, we would observe the largest possible area of water. (See figs. 3 and 4.) A remarkable fact, first noted by Mr. James Gardner, is that only one twenty-seventh of the dry land has any land directly opposite to it, which is closely related to this abundance of land in one of the two hemispheres previously mentioned. For example, in fig. 3, the land shaded in black in part of China corresponds to the area at the tip of South America and Tierra del Fuego that is antipodal to it, while the dark areas in the northern and central parts of South America represent Borneo, Sumatra, and other antipodal islands in the Eastern Archipelago. See Gardner, Geol. Soc. Proceedings, 1833, vol. i. p. 488.

193 Humboldt on Isothermal Lines

Humboldt on Isothermal Lines

194 Humboldt, Tableaux de la Nature, tom. i. p. 112.

194 Humboldt, Nature's Snapshots, vol. 1, p. 112.

195 Ad. Brongniart, Consid. Générales sur la Nat. de la Végét. &c. Ann. des Sciences Nat., Nov. 1828.

195 Ad. Brongniart, General Considerations on the Nature of Vegetation, etc. Annals of Natural Sciences, Nov. 1828.

196 Sir J. Richardson, Proceedings of Geol. Soc. No. 7, p. 68, March, 1828.

196 Sir J. Richardson, Proceedings of Geol. Soc. No. 7, p. 68, March, 1828.

197 Ad. Brongniart, Consid. Générales sur la Nat. de la Végét. &c., Ann. des Sci. Nat., Nov. 1828.

197 A. Brongniart, General Considerations on the Nature of Vegetation, Annals of Natural Sciences, Nov. 1828.

198 See a Memoir on the Alps, by Professor Sedgwick and Sir Rod. Murchison, Trans. of Geol. Soc. second ser. vol. iii. accompanied by a map.

198 Check out "A Memoir on the Alps" by Professor Sedgwick and Sir Rod. Murchison, Trans. of Geol. Soc. second ser. vol. iii. with a map included.

199 See Proceedings of Geol. Soc. vol. ii. p. 334.

199 See Proceedings of the Geological Society, volume II, page 334.

200 It may be observed, that the facts and inferences exhibited in this map bear not merely on the theory of climate above proposed, but serve also to illustrate the views explained in the third book respecting the migration of animals and plants and the gradual extinction of species.

200 It can be noted that the facts and conclusions shown in this map relate not only to the climate theory mentioned above but also help illustrate the ideas discussed in the third book regarding the migration of animals and plants and the gradual extinction of species.

201 See Sir R. Murchison's Paper on the Alps, Quart. Journ. Geol. Soc. vol. v. and my Anniversary Address for 1850, ibid. vol. vi.

201 Check out Sir R. Murchison's paper on the Alps in the Quarterly Journal of the Geological Society, volume five, and my Anniversary Address for 1850 in volume six.

202 Allgemeine Literatur Zeitung, No. cxxxix. July, 1833.

202 General Literary Journal, No. 139. July, 1833.

203 In this estimate, the space within the antarctic circle is not taken into account: if included, it would probably add to the excess of dry land; for the late discoveries of Capt. Sir James Ross, who penetrated to lat. 78° 10' S., confirm the conjecture of Captain Cook that the accumulation of antarctic ice implies the presence of a certain quantity of terra firma. The number of square miles on the surface of the globe are 148,522,000, the part occupied by the sea being 110,849,000, and that by land, 37,673,000; so that the land is very nearly to the sea as 1 part in 4. I am informed by Mr. Gardner that, according to a rough approximation, the land between the 30° N. lat. and the pole occupies a space about equal to that of the sea, and the land between the 30° S. lat. and the antarctic circle about one-sixteenth of that zone.

203 In this estimate, the area within the Antarctic Circle is not considered: if it were included, it would likely increase the amount of dry land; the recent findings of Captain Sir James Ross, who traveled to lat. 78° 10' S., support Captain Cook’s theory that the buildup of Antarctic ice suggests the existence of a certain amount of solid ground. The total number of square miles on the Earth's surface is 148,522,000, with the sea covering 110,849,000 and land covering 37,673,000; thus, land is roughly one part for every four parts of sea. Mr. Gardner informs me that, based on a rough estimate, the land between lat. 30° N. and the pole occupies an area about equal to that of the sea, and the land between lat. 30° S. and the Antarctic Circle makes up about one-sixteenth of that region.

204 See papers by Mr. Smith of Jordanhill, F. G. S., and the author, Proceedings Geol. Soc. No. 63, 1839, also that of Prof. E. Forbes, before cited, p. 86, note.

204 See papers by Mr. Smith of Jordanhill, F. G. S., and the author, Proceedings Geol. Soc. No. 63, 1839, as well as the one by Prof. E. Forbes mentioned earlier, p. 86, note.

205 The theorem is thus stated:—"The eccentricity of the orbit varying, the total quantity of heat received by the earth from the sun in one revolution is inversely proportional to the minor axis of the orbit. The major axis is invariable, and therefore, of course, the absolute length of the year: hence it follows that the mean annual average of heat will also be in the same inverse ratio of the minor axis."—Geol. Trans. second series, vol. iii. p. 295.

205 The theorem is stated as follows: "As the eccentricity of the orbit changes, the total amount of heat that the earth receives from the sun during one complete orbit is inversely proportional to the length of the minor axis of the orbit. The major axis remains constant, which means the absolute length of the year also remains constant; therefore, it follows that the average annual heat will also be in the same inverse relationship with the minor axis."—Geol. Trans. second series, vol. iii. p. 295.

206 Ann. du Bur. des Long. 1834.

206 Ann. du Bur. des Long. 1834.

207 Poisson, Théorie Mathémat. de la Chaleur, Comptes Rendus de l'Acad. des Sci., Jan. 30, 1837.

207 Poisson, Mathematical Theory of Heat, Proceedings of the Academy of Sciences, Jan. 30, 1837.

208 Quart. Journ. Geol. Soc. 1852, p. 62.

208 Quarterly Journal of the Geological Society, 1852, p. 62.

209 Proceedings Roy. Astronom. Soc. No. iii. Jan. 1840.

209 Proceedings Royal Astronomical Society No. iii. January 1840.

210 See a Memoir on the Temperature of the Terrestrial Globe, and the Planetary Spaces, Ann. de Chimie et Phys. tom. xxvii. p. 136. Oct. 1824.

210 Check out a Memoir on the Temperature of the Earth and the Planetary Spaces, Ann. de Chimie et Phys. vol. xxvii. p. 136. Oct. 1824.

211 Sir H. Davy, Consolations in Travel: Dialogue III. "The Unknown."

211 Sir H. Davy, Consolations in Travel: Dialogue III. "The Unknown."

212 Quart. Journ. Geol. Soc. 1852.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Quart. Journ. Geol. Soc. 1852.

213 Buckland's Bridgewater Treatise, p. 409.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Buckland's Bridgewater Treatise, p. 409.

214 Owen's Report on "British Fossil Reptiles, to Brit. Soc." 1841, p. 200.

214 Owen's Report on "British Fossil Reptiles, to Brit. Soc." 1841, p. 200.

215 Quart. Journ. Geol. Soc. No. 6, p. 96.

215 Quart. Journ. Geol. Soc. No. 6, p. 96.

216 See Hitchcock's Report on Geol. of Massachusetts, and Lyell's Travels in North America, chap. 12.

216 See Hitchcock's Report on the Geology of Massachusetts, and Lyell's Travels in North America, chapter 12.

217 See Manual of Geol. by the Author, index Microlestes.

217 See the Author's Manual of Geology, index Microlestes.

218 This figure (No. 8) is from a drawing by Professor C. Prevost, published Ann. des Sci. Nat. Avril, 1825. The fossil is a lower jaw, adhering by its inner side to the slab of oolite, in which it is sunk. The form of the condyle, or posterior process of the jaw, is convex, agreeing with the mammiferous type, and is distinctly seen, an impression of it being left on the stone, although in this specimen the bone is wanting. The anterior part of the jaw has been partially broken away, so that the double fangs of the molar teeth are seen fixed in their sockets, the form of the fangs being characteristic of the mammalia. Ten molars are preserved, and the place of an eleventh is believed to be apparent. The enamel of some of the teeth is well preserved.

218 This figure (No. 8) is from a drawing by Professor C. Prevost, published in Ann. des Sci. Nat. April, 1825. The fossil is a lower jaw, attached by its inner side to the slab of oolite in which it is embedded. The shape of the condyle, or the back part of the jaw, is rounded, matching the characteristics of mammals, and is clearly visible, with an impression of it left on the stone, although the bone itself is missing in this specimen. The front part of the jaw is partially broken, allowing the double fangs of the molar teeth to be seen in their sockets, with the shape of the fangs typical of mammals. There are ten molars preserved, and the spot for an eleventh is thought to be visible. The enamel on some of the teeth is well preserved.

219 A colored figure of this small and elegant quadruped is given in the Trans. Zool. Soc. vol. ii. pl. 28. It is insectivorous, and was taken in a hollow tree, in a country abounding in ant-hills, ninety miles to the southeast of the mouth of Swan River in Australia.—It is the first living marsupial species known to have nine molar teeth in the lower jaw, and some of the teeth are widely separated from others, one of the peculiarities in the thylacotherium of Stonesfield, which at first induced M. Blainville to refer that creature to the class of reptiles.

219 A colored illustration of this small and elegant four-legged animal can be found in the Trans. Zool. Soc. vol. ii. pl. 28. It feeds on insects and was found in a hollow tree in an area rich in ant hills, ninety miles southeast of the mouth of Swan River in Australia. — It is the first known living marsupial species with nine molar teeth in the lower jaw, and some of the teeth are spaced far apart from each other, which is one of the unique features of the thylacotherium from Stonesfield, leading M. Blainville to initially classify that creature as a reptile.

220 This figure (No. 10) was taken from the original, formerly in Mr. Broderip's collection, and now in the British Museum. It consists of the right half of a lower jaw, of which the inner side is seen. The jaw contains seven molar teeth, one canine, and three incisors; but the end of the jaw is fractured, and traces of the alveolus of a fourth incisor are seen. With this addition, the number of teeth would agree exactly with those of a lower jaw of a didelphis. The fossil is well preserved in a slab of oolitic structure containing shells of trigoniæ and other marine remains. Two or three other similar jaws, besides those above represented, have been procured from the quarries of Stonesfield.—See Broderip, Zool. Journ. vol. ii. p. 408. Owen, Proceedings Geol. Soc., November, 1838.

220 This figure (No. 10) was taken from the original, which was once in Mr. Broderip's collection and is now in the British Museum. It shows the right half of a lower jaw from the inside. The jaw has seven molar teeth, one canine, and three incisors; however, the end of the jaw is broken, and there are signs of the socket for a fourth incisor. If this tooth were included, the total number would match exactly with that of a lower jaw of a didelphis. The fossil is well-preserved in a slab of oolitic rock that also contains shells of trigoniæ and other marine fossils. Two or three other similar jaws, in addition to the one shown, have been obtained from the Stonesfield quarries. —See Broderip, Zool. Journ. vol. ii. p. 408. Owen, Proceedings Geol. Soc., November, 1838.

221 Darwin's Journal, chap. 19. Lyell's Manual of Geol. chap. 21, p. 279.

221 Darwin's Journal, chapter 19. Lyell's Manual of Geology, chapter 21, page 279.

222 Taylor's Annals of Nat. Hist. Nov. 1839.

222 Taylor's Annals of Nat. Hist. Nov. 1839.

223 See notice by the Author, and Professor Owen, Taylor's Annals of Nat. Hist. Nov. 1839.

223 See notice by the Author, and Professor Owen, Taylor's Annals of Nat. Hist. Nov. 1839.

224 See Principles of Geology, 1st ed. 1830, vol. i p. 152.

224 See Principles of Geology, 1st ed. 1830, vol. i p. 152.

225 The first quadrumanous fossils discovered in India were observed in 1836 in the Sewalik Hills, a lower range of the Himalayan Mountains, by Lieutenants Baker and Durond, by whom their osteological characters were determined (Journ. of Asiat. Soc. of Bengal, vol. v. p. 739), and in the year following, other fossils of the same class were brought to light and described by Capt. Cantley and Dr. Falconer. These were imbedded, like the former, in tertiary strata of conglomerate, sand, marl, and clay, in the Sub-Himalayan Mountains. (Ibid. vol. v. p. 379. Nov. 1836; and vol. vi. p. 354. May, 1837.)

225 The first quadrupedal fossils found in India were discovered in 1836 in the Sewalik Hills, a lower range of the Himalayan Mountains, by Lieutenants Baker and Durond, who identified their osteological features (Journ. of Asiat. Soc. of Bengal, vol. v. p. 739). In the following year, additional fossils of the same type were uncovered and described by Capt. Cantley and Dr. Falconer. Like the earlier findings, these were embedded in tertiary layers of conglomerate, sand, marl, and clay in the Sub-Himalayan Mountains. (Ibid. vol. v. p. 379. Nov. 1836; and vol. vi. p. 354. May, 1837.)

The Brazilian quadrumane was found, with a great many other extinct species of animals, by a Danish naturalist, Dr. Lund, between the rivers Francisco and Velhas, in 1837.

The Brazilian monkey was discovered, along with many other extinct animal species, by a Danish naturalist, Dr. Lund, between the Francisco and Velhas rivers in 1837.

The gibbon of the South of France was found by M. Lartet in the beginning of 1837, and determined by M. de Blainville. It occurred near Auch, in the department of Gers, about forty miles west of Toulouse, in freshwater marl, limestone, and sand. They were accompanied by the remains of the mastodon, dinotherium, palæotherium, rhinoceros, gigantic sloth, and other extinct quadrupeds. (Bulletin de la Soc. Geol. de France, tom. viii. p. 92.)

The gibbon from southern France was discovered by M. Lartet in early 1837 and identified by M. de Blainville. It was found near Auch, in the Gers department, about forty miles west of Toulouse, in freshwater marl, limestone, and sand. The site also contained remains of the mastodon, dinotherium, palæotherium, rhinoceros, gigantic sloth, and other extinct mammals. (Bulletin de la Soc. Geol. de France, tom. viii. p. 92.)

The British quadrumane was discovered in 1839, by Messrs. William Colchester and Searles Wood, at Kyson, near Woodbridge, in Suffolk, and was referred by Professor Owen to the genus Macacus. (Mag. of Nat. Hist. Sept. 1839. Taylor, Annals of Nat. Hist. No. xxiii. Nov. 1839.)

The British quadrumane was found in 1839 by William Colchester and Searles Wood in Kyson, near Woodbridge, Suffolk, and Professor Owen classified it under the genus Macacus. (Mag. of Nat. Hist. Sept. 1839. Taylor, Annals of Nat. Hist. No. xxiii. Nov. 1839.)

226 Owen's Introduction to British Fossil Mammals, p. 46.

226 Owen's Introduction to British Fossil Mammals, p. 46.

227 Proceedings of Acad. Nat. Sci. Philad. Dec. 9, 1851.

227 Proceedings of Acad. Nat. Sci. Philad. December 9, 1851.

228 See ch. 48.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ See chapter 48.

229 Ibid.

Ibid.

230 Ibid.

Ibid.

231 Phys. Hist. of Mankind, vol. ii. p. 594.

231 Phys. Hist. of Mankind, vol. ii. p. 594.

232 Virgil, Eclog. iv. For an account of these doctrines, see Dugald Stewart's Elements of the Philosophy of the Human Mind, vol. ii. chap. ii. sect. 4, and Prichard's Egypt. Mythol. p. 177.

232 Virgil, Eclog. iv. For more on these ideas, check out Dugald Stewart's Elements of the Philosophy of the Human Mind, vol. ii. chap. ii. sect. 4, and Prichard's Egypt. Mythol. p. 177.

233 See ch. 41.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ See chapter 41.

234 See ch. 35.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ See chap. 35.

235 See ch. 37, 38, 39, 41.

235 See ch. 37, 38, 39, 41.

236 See also Manual of Geology, ch. 11, 12.

236 See also Manual of Geology, ch. 11, 12.

237 It has been suspected ever since the middle of the last century, that the Caspian was lower than the ocean, it being known that in Astrakhan the mercury in the barometer generally stands above thirty inches. In 1811, MM. Engelhardt and Parrot attempted to determine the exact amount of difference by a series of levellings and barometrical measurements across the isthmus at two different places near the foot of Mount Caucasus. The result of their operations led them to the opinion that the Caspian was more than 300 feet below the Black Sea. But the correctness of the observations having afterwards been called in question, M. Parrot revisited the ground in 1829 and 1830, and inferred from new levellings, that the mouth of the Don was between three and four feet lower than that of the Wolga; in other words, that the sea of Azof, which communicates with the Black Sea, was actually lower than the Caspian! Other statements, no less contradictory, having been made by other observers, the Russian government at length directed the Academy of St. Petersburg to send an expedition, in 1836, to decide the point by a trigonometrical survey, from which it appeared that the Caspian is 101 Russian, or 108 English, feet lower than the Black Sea. (For authorities, see Journ. Roy. Geograph. Soc. vol. viii. p. 135). Sir R. Murchison, however, concludes, in 1845, from the best Russian authorities, that the depression of the Caspian is only 83 feet 6 inches.

237 It has been suspected since the middle of the last century that the Caspian Sea is lower than the ocean, as it's known that in Astrakhan the mercury in the barometer usually reads above thirty inches. In 1811, MM. Engelhardt and Parrot tried to measure the exact difference by conducting a series of levelings and barometric readings across the isthmus at two different locations near the base of Mount Caucasus. Their findings suggested that the Caspian Sea was more than 300 feet below the Black Sea. However, since the accuracy of their observations was later questioned, M. Parrot returned to the area in 1829 and 1830. From new levelings, he concluded that the mouth of the Don River was between three and four feet lower than that of the Volga River; in other words, the Sea of Azov, which connects to the Black Sea, was actually lower than the Caspian! With other contradictory claims made by different observers, the Russian government eventually instructed the Academy of St. Petersburg to send an expedition in 1836 to settle the matter through a trigonometrical survey. The survey indicated that the Caspian is 101 Russian feet, or 108 English feet, lower than the Black Sea. (For authorities, see Journ. Roy. Geograph. Soc. vol. viii. p. 135). However, Sir R. Murchison concluded in 1845, based on the best Russian sources, that the Caspian's depression is only 83 feet 6 inches.

The measurements of Major Anthony Symonds, since confirmed by French authorities, make the Dead Sea to be 1200 feet below the Mediterranean.

The measurements of Major Anthony Symonds, now confirmed by French authorities, show that the Dead Sea is 1200 feet below sea level compared to the Mediterranean.

238 See Lyell's Travels in N. America, ch. 2 and 25.

238 See Lyell's Travels in North America, chapters 2 and 25.

239 See Manual of Geology, chap. 29 to 33, inclusive.

239 See the Manual of Geology, chapters 29 to 33, inclusive.

240 See ch. 26, infrà.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ See ch. 26, below.

241 See ch. 27, infrà.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ See ch. 27, below.

242 Ann. des Sci. Nat., Septembre, Novembre, et Décembre, 1829. Revue Française, No. 15, May, 1830. Bulletin de la Société Géol. de France, p. 864, May, 1847. The latest edition of M. de Beaumont's theory will be found in the 12th vol. of the Dictionnaire Universel d'Hist. Nat. 1852, art. "Systèmes des Montagues;" also the same printed separately.

242 Ann. des Sci. Nat., September, November, and December, 1829. Revue Française, No. 15, May, 1830. Bulletin de la Société Géol. de France, p. 864, May, 1847. The latest edition of M. de Beaumont's theory can be found in the 12th volume of the Dictionnaire Universel d'Hist. Nat. 1852, article "Systèmes des Montagues;" also available separately in print.

243 Système de Mont. p. 762.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Mont System. p. 762.

244 Ibid. pp. 761 and 773.

244 Same source, pages 761 and 773.

245 Phil. Mag. and Annals, No. 58. New Series, p. 242.

245 Phil. Mag. and Annals, No. 58. New Series, p. 242.

246 Système de Montagnes, 1852, p. 429.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Mountain System, 1852, p. 429.

247 Phil. Mag. and Annals, No. 58. New series, p. 243.

247 Phil. Mag. and Annals, No. 58. New series, p. 243.

248 Système de Montagnes, 1852, p. 429.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Mountain System, 1852, p. 429.

249 For page, see Index, "Hopkins."

249 For the page, see the Index under "Hopkins."

250 Art. Système de Montagnes, p. 775.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Art. Mountain System, p. 775.

251 M. E de Beaumont in his later inquiries (Comptes rendus, Sept. 1850, and Systèmes des Montagnes) has come to the conclusion, that the principal mountain ranges, if prolonged, would intersect each other at certain angles, so as to produce a regular geometric arrangement, which he calls "a pentagonal network." This theory has been ably discussed and controverted by Mr. Hopkins, in his Anniversary Address as President of the Geol. Soc., Feb. 1853.

251 M. E de Beaumont, in his later research (Comptes rendus, Sept. 1850, and Systèmes des Montagnes), concluded that the main mountain ranges, if extended, would cross each other at specific angles, creating a regular geometric pattern that he refers to as "a pentagonal network." This theory has been skillfully debated and challenged by Mr. Hopkins in his Anniversary Address as President of the Geol. Soc., Feb. 1853.

252 Darwin's Geology of South America, p. 248. London, 1846.

252 Darwin's Geology of South America, p. 248. London, 1846.

253 Système de Montagnes, p. 748.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Mountain System, p. 748.

254 See Lyell's Manual of Elementary Geology, ch. 5.

254 See Lyell's Manual of Elementary Geology, ch. 5.

255 See the Author's Anniversary Address, Quart. Journ. Geol. Soc. 1850, vol. vi. p. 46, from which some of the above passages are extracted.

255 Check out the Author's Anniversary Address, Quart. Journ. Geol. Soc. 1850, vol. vi. p. 46, which includes some of the passages mentioned above.

256 See Lyell's Manual of Elementary Geology.

256 See Lyell's Manual of Elementary Geology.

257 Reports to Brit. Assoc. 1842, 1843, and Introd. to Brit. Foss. Mamm. p. 31. The conchological evidence respecting the British Miocene, Pliocene, and Pleistocene fossils, examined by Mr. Forbes, in the paper before cited, p. 88, note, bear out some of the most important conclusions of M. Deshayes, quoted by me in the first edition of the Principles, 1831, and the recent observations of Philippi in regard to the passage of species from one formation to another. I refer to these authorities more especially because this doctrine of a gradual transition has been opposed by some living naturalists of high distinction, among whom I may mention M.A. d'Orbigny and M. Agassiz. I have long been convinced that we must abandon many of the identifications formerly made of Eocene with recent shells; but some errors of this kind do not affect the general reasoning on the subject. See a discussion on this question, Quarterly Journ. of Geog. Soc., No. 5, p. 47 Feb. 1846.

257 Reports to Brit. Assoc. 1842, 1843, and Introd. to Brit. Foss. Mamm. p. 31. The conchological evidence regarding the British Miocene, Pliocene, and Pleistocene fossils, examined by Mr. Forbes in the previously mentioned paper, p. 88, note, supports some of the key conclusions of M. Deshayes, which I referenced in the first edition of the Principles, 1831, as well as the recent observations from Philippi about the transition of species between formations. I mention these authorities particularly because the idea of gradual transition has been challenged by several prominent living naturalists, including M.A. d'Orbigny and M. Agassiz. I have long been convinced that we need to let go of many of the identifications that were previously made between Eocene and recent shells; however, some of these errors do not impact the overall reasoning on the subject. See a discussion on this question in the Quarterly Journ. of Geog. Soc., No. 5, p. 47 Feb. 1846.

258 Darwin's Journal, p. 163. 2d. ed. p. 139.

258 Darwin's Journal, p. 163. 2nd ed. p. 139.

259 Journ. Roy. Geograph. Soc. vol. iii. p. 142.

259 Journ. Roy. Geograph. Soc. vol. iii. p. 142.

260 Book iii. ch. 50.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Book 3, ch. 50.

261 Darwin's S. America, pp. 136, 139.

261 Darwin's South America, pp. 136, 139.

262 Miller, Phil. Trans. 1851, p. 155.

262 Miller, Phil. Trans. 1851, p. 155.

263 Phil. Trans. 1850, p. 354.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Phil. Trans. 1850, p. 354.

264 Hooker's Himalayan Journal, ined.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Hooker's Himalayan Journal, unpublished.

265 Ibid.

Ibid.

266 See Manual of Geology, Index, Rain-prints.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ See Geology Manual, Index, Rain-prints.

267 See Lyell on recent and fossil rains. Quart. Journ. Geol. Soc. 1851, vol. vii. p. 239.

267 See Lyell on recent and fossil rains. Quart. Journ. Geol. Soc. 1851, vol. vii. p. 239.

268 Lyell's Second Visit to the United States, 1846, vol. ii. p. 25.

268 Lyell's Second Visit to the United States, 1846, vol. ii. p. 25.

269 Encyc. Brit. art. Rivers.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Encyclopaedia Britannica article Rivers.

270 Sir T. D. Lauder's Account of the Great Floods in Morayshire, August, 1829.

270 Sir T. D. Lauder's Description of the Major Floods in Morayshire, August 1829.

271 Quarterly Jour. of Sci. &c. No. xii. New Series, p. 331.

271 Quarterly Journal of Science & etc. No. 12. New Series, p. 331.

272 Culley, Proceed. Geol. Soc. 1829.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Culley, Proc. Geol. Soc. 1829.

273 Silliman's Journal, vol. xv. No. 2, p. 216. Jan. 1829.

273 Silliman's Journal, vol. 15, No. 2, p. 216. Jan. 1829.

274 Silliman's Journal, vol. xxxiv. p. 115.

274 Silliman's Journal, vol. 34, p. 115.

275 See Lyell's Second Visit to the U. S. vol. i. p. 69.

275 See Lyell's Second Visit to the U.S. vol. i. p. 69.

276 This block was measured by Capt. B. Hall, R. N.

276 This section was measured by Captain B. Hall, Royal Navy.

277 Inundation of the Val de Bagnes, in 1818, Ed. Phil. Journ., vol. i. p. 187, from memoir of M. Escher.

277 Flooding of the Val de Bagnes in 1818, Ed. Phil. Journ., vol. i. p. 187, from the memoir of M. Escher.

278 Lib. viii. Epist. 17.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Book VIII, Letter 17.

279 When at Tivoli, in 1829, I received this account from eye-witnesses of the event.

279 When I was in Tivoli in 1829, I got this account from people who saw the event happen.

280 Illustr. of Hutt. Theory, § 3, p. 147.

280 Illustr. of Hutt. Theory, § 3, p. 147.

281 Quadro Istorico dell' Etna, 1824.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ History of Etna, 1824.

282 The reader will find in my Travels in North America, vol. i. ch. 2, a colored geological map and section of the Niagara district, also a bird's-eye view of the Falls and adjacent country, colored geologically, of which the first idea was suggested by the excellent original sketch given by Mr. Bakewell. I have referred more fully to these and to Mr. Hall's Report on the Geology of New York, as well as to the earlier writings of Hennepin and Kalm in the same work, and have speculated on the origin of the escarpment over which the Falls may have been originally precipitated. Vol. i. p. 32, and vol. ii. p. 93.

282 In my Travels in North America, vol. i. ch. 2, you will find a colorful geological map and cross-section of the Niagara area, along with a geologically colored bird's-eye view of the Falls and surrounding region, inspired by the excellent original sketch by Mr. Bakewell. I've gone into more detail about these, as well as Mr. Hall's Report on the Geology of New York, along with the earlier writings of Hennepin and Kalm in the same work, and I've considered the origin of the escarpment over which the Falls may have originally tumbled. Vol. i. p. 32, and vol. ii. p. 93.

283 Consid. sur les Blocs Errat. 1829.

283 Considerations on the Erratic Blocks. 1829.

284 Capt. Bayfield, Geol. Soc. Proceedings, vol. ii. p. 223.

284 Capt. Bayfield, Geological Society Proceedings, vol. 2, p. 223.

285 M. Arago, Annuaire, &c. 1833; and Rev. J. Farquharson, Phil. Trans. 1835, p. 329.

285 M. Arago, Annuaire, &c. 1833; and Rev. J. Farquharson, Phil. Trans. 1835, p. 329.

286 Journ. of Roy. Geograph. Soc. vol. vi. p. 416.

286 Journal of Royal Geographical Society vol. 6 p. 416.

287 See Système Glaciaire, by Agassiz, Guyot, and Desor, pp. 436, 437, 445. Mr. Agassiz, at p. 462, states that he published in the Deutsche Vierteljahrschrift for 1841, this result as to the central motion being greater than that of the sides, and was, therefore, the first to correct his own previous mistake.

287 See Système Glaciaire, by Agassiz, Guyot, and Desor, pp. 436, 437, 445. Mr. Agassiz, on p. 462, mentions that he published in the Deutsche Vierteljahrschrift in 1841, this finding that the central motion is greater than that of the sides, and was, therefore, the first to correct his earlier error.

288 J. Forbes. 8th Letter on Glaciers, Aug. 1844.

288 J. Forbes. 8th Letter on Glaciers, Aug. 1844.

289 See Mr. Hopkins on Motion of Glaciers, Cambridge Phil. Trans. 1844, and Phil. Mag. 1845. Some of the late concessions of this author as to a certain plasticity in the mass, appear to me to make the difference between him and Professor Forbes little more than one of degree. (For the latest summary of Prof. Forbes' views, see Phil. Trans. 1846, pt. 2.)

289 Check out Mr. Hopkins' work on Glacier Movement in the Cambridge Philosophical Transactions from 1844 and the Philosophical Magazine from 1845. Some of the recent acknowledgments he made regarding a certain plasticity in the ice seem to indicate that the difference between his views and Professor Forbes' is really just a matter of degree. (For the most recent overview of Prof. Forbes' ideas, see Phil. Trans. 1846, pt. 2.)

290 This experiment is cited by Mr. Forbes, Phil. Trans. 1846, p. 206; and I have conversed with Mr. Christie on the subject.

290 This experiment is referenced by Mr. Forbes in the Philosophical Transactions of 1846, page 206; and I have talked with Mr. Christie about it.

291 Etudes sur les Glaciers, 1840.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Glacier Studies, 1840.

292 See Manual of Geol. ch. xi.

292 See Manual of Geol. ch. xi.

293 Agassiz, Jam. Ed. New Phil. Journ. No. 54, p. 388.

293 Agassiz, Jam. Ed. New Phil. Journ. No. 54, p. 388.

294 Charpentier, Ann. des Mines, tom. viii.; see also Papers by MM. Venetz and Agassiz.

294 Charpentier, Ann. des Mines, vol. viii.; see also Papers by Messrs. Venetz and Agassiz.

295 Voyage in 1822, p. 233.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Trip in 1822, p. 233.

296 Travels in Norway.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Travels in Norway.

297 Darwin's Journal, p. 283.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Darwin's Journal, p. 283.

298 Journ. of Roy. Geograph. Soc. vol. ix. p. 526.

298 Journal of the Royal Geographical Society, volume 9, page 526.

299 Journ. of Roy. Geograph. Soc. vol. ix. p. 529.

299 Journal of Royal Geographical Society vol. 9 p. 529.

300 Ibid. vol. viii. p. 221.

300 Same source, vol. viii, p. 221.

301 In my Travels in N. America, pp. 19, 23, &c., and Second Visit to the U. S., vol. i. ch. 2, also in my Manual of Geology, a more full account of the action of floating ice and coast-ice, and its bearing on geology, will be found.

301 In my Travels in N. America, pp. 19, 23, etc., and Second Visit to the U. S., vol. i. ch. 2, you can find a more detailed account of how floating ice and coast-ice work and their impact on geology in my Manual of Geology.

302 Jam. Ed. New Phil. Journ. No. xlviii. p. 439.

302 Jam. Ed. New Phil. Journ. No. xlviii. p. 439.

303 Bulletin de la Soc. Géol. de France, 1847, tom. iv. pp. 1182, 1183.

303 Bulletin of the Geological Society of France, 1847, vol. iv, pp. 1182, 1183.

304 Consult J. Prestwich, Water-bearing Strata around London. 1851. (Van Voorst)

304 Check out J. Prestwich, Water-bearing Strata around London. 1851. (Van Voorst)

305 Sabine, Journ. of Sci. No. xxxiii. p. 72. 1824.

305 Sabine, Journal of Science No. 33, p. 72. 1824.

306 Héricart de Thury, "Puits Forés," p. 49.

306 Héricart de Thury, "Puits Forés," p. 49.

307 Prestwich, p. 69.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Prestwich, p. 69.

308 Bull. de la Soc. Géol. de France, tom. iii. p. 194.

308 Bull. de la Soc. Géol. de France, vol. iii, p. 194.

309 Boué Résumé des Prog. de la Géol. en 1832, p. 184.

309 Boué Summary of Geological Programs in 1832, p. 184.

310 Seventh Rep. Brit. Ass. 1837, p. 66.

310 Seventh Report, British Association, 1837, p. 66.

311 H. de Thury, p. 295.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ H. de Thury, p. 295.

312 Bull. de la Soc. Géol de France, tom. i. p. 93.

312 Bull. de la Soc. Géol de France, vol. 1, p. 93.

313 Bull. de la Soc. Géol. de France, tom. ii. p. 248.

313 Bull. de la Soc. Géol. de France, vol. ii. p. 248.

314 See Glossary, "Tufa," "Travertin."

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ See Glossary, "Tufa," "Travertine."

315 Dr. Grosse on the Baths of San Filippo, Ed. Phil. Journ. vol. ii p. 292.

315 Dr. Grosse on the Baths of San Filippo, Phil. Journ. vol. ii p. 292.

316 Consolations in Travel, pp. 123-125.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Travel Comforts, pp. 123-125.

317 Ibid. p. 127.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Same source, p. 127.

318 C. Prevost, Essai sur la Constitution Physique du Bassin de Vienne, p. 10.

318 C. Prevost, Essay on the Physical Structure of the Vienna Basin, p. 10.

319 Travels across the Andes, p. 240.

319 Travels across the Andes, p. 240.

320 Annalen der Chem. 1847.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Annals of Chemistry 1847.

321 Daubeny on Volcanoes, p. 222.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Daubeny on Volcanoes, p. 222.

322 Dr. Webster on the Hot Springs of Furnas, Ed. Phil. Journ. vol. vi. p. 306.

322 Dr. Webster on the Hot Springs of Furnas, Ed. Phil. Journ. vol. vi. p. 306.

323 See a cut of the Icelandic geyser, chap. 32.

323 Check out a clip of the Icelandic geyser, chap. 32.

324 M. Robert, Bullétin de la Soc. Géol. de France, tom. vii. p. 11.

324 M. Robert, Bulletin of the Geological Society of France, vol. VII, p. 11.

325 Barrow's Iceland, p. 209.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Barrow's Iceland, p. 209.

326 See Lyell's Manual of Elementary Geology; and Dr. Turner, Jam. Ed. New Phil. Journ. No. xxx. p. 246.

326 Check out Lyell's Manual of Elementary Geology; and Dr. Turner, Jam. Ed. New Phil. Journ. No. xxx. p. 246.

327 L. Horner, Geol. Trans, vol. ii. p. 94.

327 L. Horner, Geol. Trans, vol. ii. p. 94.

328 Ann. de l'Auvergne, tome i. p. 234.

328 Ann. de l'Auvergne, vol. 1, p. 234.

329 Ann. Scient. de l'Auvergne, tome ii. June, 1829.

329 Ann. Scient. de l'Auvergne, vol. II. June, 1829.

330 Edinb. New Phil. Journ. Oct. 1839.

330 Edinb. New Phil. Journ. Oct. 1839.

331 See Lyell's Travels in N. America, vol. i p. 150.

331 See Lyell's Travels in North America, vol. 1, p. 150.

332 Symes, Embassy to Ava, vol. ii. Geol. Trans. second series, vol. ii. part iii. p. 388.

332 Symes, Embassy to Ava, vol. ii. Geol. Trans. second series, vol. ii. part iii. p. 388.

333 Dr. Nugent, Geol. Trans. vol. i. p. 69.

333 Dr. Nugent, Geol. Trans. vol. i. p. 69.

334 Ibid. p. 67.

Ibid. p. 67.

335 De la Beche, Ed. Phil. Journ. vol. ii. p. 107. Jan. 1820.

335 De la Beche, Ed. Phil. Journ. vol. ii. p. 107. Jan. 1820.

336 De la Beche, MS.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ De la Beche, MS.

337 De la Beche, MS.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ De la Beche, MS.

338 Trans. of Lit. and Hist. Soc. of Quebec, vol. i. p. 5, 1829.

338 Trans. of Lit. and Hist. Soc. of Quebec, vol. i. p. 5, 1829.

339 Prony, see Cuvier, Disc. Prelim, p. 146.

339 Prony, see Cuvier, Preliminary Discourse, p. 146.

340 See De Beaumont, Géologie Pratique, vol. i. p. 323, 1844.

340 See De Beaumont, Practical Geology, vol. i. p. 323, 1844.

341 Prony, cited by Cuvier, Discours Prélimin.

341 Prony, quoted by Cuvier, Preliminary Discourse.

342 Brocchi, Conch. Foss. Subap. vol. i. p. 118.

342 Brocchi, Conch. Foss. Subap. vol. i. p. 118.

343 Archiac, Histoire des Progrés de la Géol. 1848, vol. ii. p. 232.

343 Archaic, History of Geological Progress, 1848, vol. ii. p. 232.

344 Brocchi, Conch. Foss. Subap. vol. i. p. 39.

344 Brocchi, Conch. Foss. Subap. vol. i. p. 39.

345 Ibid. vol. ii. p. 94.

345 Same source, vol. ii, p. 94.

346 Mém. d'Astruc, cited by Von Hoff, vol. i. p. 288.

346 Memoirs of Astruc, referenced by Von Hoff, vol. i. p. 288.

347 Lib. ii. c. v.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Book 2, Chapter 5

348 Bouche, Chorographie et Hist. de Provence, vol. i. p. 23, cited by Von Hoft, vol. i. p. 290.

348 Bouche, Chorography and History of Provence, vol. i. p. 23, cited by Von Hoft, vol. i. p. 290.

349 Hist. Phys. de la Mer.

349 History of the Physics of the Sea.

350 Karamania, or a brief Description of the Coast of Asia Minor, &c. London, 1817.

350 Karamania, or a Short Description of the Coast of Asia Minor, etc. London, 1817.

351 Geog. Syst. of Herod, vol. ii. p. 107.

351 Geographic Systems of Herod, vol. ii. p. 107.

352 Euterpe, XI.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Euterpe, XI.

353 Journ. of Roy. Geograph. Soc. vol. ix. p. 432.

353 Journal of the Royal Geographical Society, volume nine, page 432.

354 Quart. Journ. Geol. Soc. vol. v.; Memoirs, p. 20; and Lassaigue, Journ. Pharm. t. v. p. 468.

354 Quart. Journ. Geol. Soc. vol. v.; Memoirs, p. 20; and Lassaigue, Journ. Pharm. t. v. p. 468.

355 Quart. Journ. Geol. Soc. 1848, vol. iv. p. 342.

355 Quart. Journ. Geol. Soc. 1848, vol. iv. p. 342.

356 Flint's Geography, vol. i. p. 142. Lyell's Second Visit to the United States, vol. ii chaps. 28 to 34.

356 Flint's Geography, vol. i. p. 142. Lyell's Second Visit to the United States, vol. ii chaps. 28 to 34.

357 Geograph. Descrip. of Louisiana, by W. Darby, Philadelphia, 1816, p. 102.

357 Geographic Description of Louisiana, by W. Darby, Philadelphia, 1816, p. 102.

358 Flint's Geography, vol. i. p. 152.

358 Flint's Geography, vol. 1, p. 152.

359 Travels in North America, vol. iii. p. 361.

359 Travels in North America, vol. iii. p. 361.

360 Travels in North America, vol. iii. p. 362.

360° Travels in North America, vol. iii. p. 362.

361 "The boats are fitted," says Captain Hall, "with what is called a snag-chamber;—a partition formed of stout planks, which is calked, and made so effectually water-tight that the foremost end of the vessel is cut off as entirely from the rest of the hold as if it belonged to another boat. If the steam-vessel happen to run against a snag, and that a hole is made in her bow, under the surface, this chamber merely fills with water."—Travels in North America, vol. iii. p. 363.

361 "The boats are equipped," says Captain Hall, "with something called a snag-chamber; it's a partition made of sturdy planks, which is sealed tightly, making it so effectively water-tight that the front end of the vessel is completely separated from the rest of the hold as if it were part of another boat. If the steamship happens to collide with a snag and a hole is created in her bow, below the surface, this chamber just fills with water."—Travels in North America, vol. iii. p. 363.

362 Darby's Louisiana, p. 33.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Darby's Louisiana, p. 33.

363 Featherstonhaugh, Geol. Report, Washington, 1835, p. 84.

363 Featherstonhaugh, Geol. Report, Washington, 1835, p. 84.

364 Trees submerged in an upright position have been observed in other parts of N. America. Thus Captains Clark and Lewis found, about the year 1807, a forest of pines standing erect under water in the body of the Columbia river, which they supposed, from the appearance of the trees, to have been submerged only about twenty years. (Travels, &c. vol. ii. p. 241.) More lately (1835), the Rev. Mr. Parker observed on the same river (lat. 45° N., long. 121° W.) trees standing in their natural position in spots where the water was more than twenty feet deep. The tops of the trees had disappeared; but between high and low water-mark the trunks were only partially decayed; and the roots were seen through the clear water, spreading as they had grown in their native forest. (Tour beyond the Rocky Mountains, p. 132.) Some have inferred from these facts that a tract of land, more than twenty miles in length, must have subsided vertically; but Capt. Fremont, Dec. 1845 (Rep. of Explor. Exped. p. 195), satisfied himself that the submerged forests have been formed by immense land-slides from the mountains, which here closely shut in the river.

364 Trees standing upright underwater have been spotted in other areas of North America. For instance, Captains Clark and Lewis discovered, around 1807, a forest of pine trees standing straight in the Columbia River, which they estimated had been submerged for only about twenty years. (Travels, &c. vol. ii. p. 241.) More recently (1835), Rev. Mr. Parker noted on the same river (lat. 45° N., long. 121° W.) trees still in their natural position in places where the water was over twenty feet deep. The tops of the trees were gone, but between the high and low water marks, the trunks were only partially decayed, and the roots were visible through the clear water, stretching out as they grew in their original forest. (Tour beyond the Rocky Mountains, p. 132.) Some have concluded from these observations that a piece of land over twenty miles long must have sunk vertically; however, Capt. Fremont, in December 1845 (Rep. of Explor. Exped. p. 195), was convinced that the submerged forests were created by massive landslides from the mountains that tightly constrict the river.

365 For an account of the "sunk country," shaken by the earthquake of 1811-12, see Lyell's Second Visit to the United States, ch. 33.

365 days For a story about the "sunk country," impacted by the earthquake of 1811-12, see Lyell's Second Visit to the United States, ch. 33.

366 Darby's Louisiana, p. 103.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Darby's Louisiana, p. 103.

367 The calculations here given were communicated to the British Association, in a lecture which I delivered at Southampton in September, 1846. (See Athenæum Journal, Sept. 26, 1846, and Report of British Association, 1846, p. 117.) Dr. Riddell has since repeated his experiments on the quantity of sediment in the river at New Orleans without any material variation in the results.

367 The calculations presented here were shared with the British Association during a talk I gave in Southampton in September 1846. (See Athenæum Journal, Sept. 26, 1846, and Report of British Association, 1846, p. 117.) Dr. Riddell has since repeated his experiments on the amount of sediment in the river at New Orleans, with no significant changes in the results.

Mr. Forshey, in a memoir on the Physics of the Mississippi, published in 1850, adopts Dr. Riddell's estimate for the quantity of mud, but takes 447,199 cubic feet per second as the average discharge of water for the year at Carrolton, nine miles above New Orleans, a result deduced from thirty years of observations. This being one-tenth more than I had assumed, would add a tenth to the sediment, and would diminish by one-eleventh the number of years required to accomplish the task above alluded to. "The cubic contents of sedimentary matter," says Forshey, "are equal to 4,083,333,333, and this sediment would annually cover twelve miles square one foot deep."

Mr. Forshey, in a memoir on the Physics of the Mississippi, published in 1850, uses Dr. Riddell's estimate for the amount of mud, but takes 447,199 cubic feet per second as the average water discharge for the year at Carrolton, nine miles above New Orleans, based on thirty years of observations. Since this is one-tenth more than I had estimated, it would increase the sediment by a tenth and would reduce the number of years needed to complete the mentioned task by one-eleventh. "The cubic volume of sedimentary matter," says Forshey, "is equal to 4,083,333,333, and this sediment would cover an area of twelve square miles one foot deep each year."

368 The Mississippi is continually shifting its course in the great alluvial plain, cutting frequently to the depth of 100, and even sometimes to the depth of 250 feet. As the old channels become afterwards filled up, or in a great degree obliterated, this excavation alone must have given a considerable depth to the basin, which receives the alluvial deposit, and subsidences like those accompanying the earthquake of New Madrid in 1811-12 may have given still more depth.

368 The Mississippi River constantly changes its path in the vast floodplain, often digging down to depths of 100, and sometimes even 250 feet. As the old channels get filled in or mostly erased, this erosion alone must have contributed significantly to the depth of the basin that collects sediment, and subsidence events like those from the New Madrid earthquakes in 1811-12 may have further increased that depth.

369 Account of the Ganges and Burrampooter rivers, by Major Rennell, Phil. Trans. 1781.

369 Account of the Ganges and Brahmaputra rivers, by Major Rennell, Phil. Trans. 1781.

370 Trans. of the Asiatic Society, vol. vii. p. 14.

370 Trans. of the Asiatic Society, vol. 7, p. 14.

371 Cuvier referred the true crocodiles of the Ganges to a single species, C. biporcatus. But I learn from Dr. Falconer that there are three well-marked species, C. biporcatus, C. palustris, and C. bombifrons. C. bombifrons occurs in the northern branches of the Ganges, 1000 miles from Calcutta; C. biporcatus appears to be confined to the estuary; and C. palustris, to range from the estuary to the central parts of Bengal. The garial is found along with C. bombifrons in the north, and descends to the region of C. biporcatus in the estuary.

371 Cuvier classified the true crocodiles of the Ganges as one species, C. biporcatus. However, I learned from Dr. Falconer that there are three distinct species: C. biporcatus, C. palustris, and C. bombifrons. C. bombifrons is found in the northern parts of the Ganges, 1000 miles from Calcutta; C. biporcatus seems to be limited to the estuary; and C. palustris ranges from the estuary to the central regions of Bengal. The garial is located alongside C. bombifrons in the north and moves down to the area of C. biporcatus in the estuary.

372 See below, ch. 22 and 29.

372 See below, ch. 22 and 29.

373 Second Visit to the United States, vol. ii. p. 145.

373 Second Visit to the United States, vol. ii. p. 145.

374 Asiatic Researches, vol. xvii. p. 466.

374 Asiatic Researches, vol. xvii. p. 466.

375 Lyell's Second Visit to the United States, vol. ii. chap. 34.

375 Lyell's Second Visit to the United States, vol. ii. chap. 34.

376 See Manual of Geology by the Author.

376 See the Author's Manual of Geology.

377 See p. 13.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ See page 13.

378 Geog. of Herod, vol ii. p. 331.

378 Geography of Herod, vol ii. p. 331.

379 Ibid. p. 328.

Ibid. p. 328.

380 Romme, Vents et Courans, vol. ii. p. 2. Rev. F. Fallows, Quart. Journ. of Science, March, 1829.

380 Romme, Winds and Currents, vol. ii. p. 2. Rev. F. Fallows, Quarterly Journal of Science, March, 1829.

381 The heights of these tides were given me by the late Captain Hewett, R. N.

381 Captain Hewett, R. N., who has since passed away, provided me with the heights of these tides.

382 On the authority of Admiral Sir F. Beaufort, R. N.

382 Based on the authority of Admiral Sir F. Beaufort, Royal Navy.

383 Consult the map of Currents by Capt. F. Beechy, R. N., Admiralty Manual, 1849, London.

383 Check out the map of Currents by Capt. F. Beechy, R. N., Admiralty Manual, 1849, London.

384 Rennell on Currents, p. 58.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Rennell on Currents, p. 58.

385 Rennell on the Channel current.

Rennell talking about the Channel current.

386 An. du Bureau des Long. 1836.

386 An. du Bureau des Long. 1836.

387 Second Parliamentary Report on Steam Communication with India, July, 1851.

387 Second Parliamentary Report on Steam Communication with India, July, 1851.

388 Phil. Trans. 1830, p. 59.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Phil. Trans. 1830, p. 59.

389 See Capt. B. Hall, On Theory of Trade Winds, Fragments of Voy. second series, vol. i., and Appendix to Daniell's Meteorology.

389 See Capt. B. Hall, On Theory of Trade Winds, Fragments of Voy. second series, vol. i., and Appendix to Daniell's Meteorology.

390 Treatise on Astronomy, chap. 3.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Astronomy Treatise, ch. 3.

391 Descrip. of Shetland Islands, p. 527, Edin. 1822, to which work I am indebted for the following representations of rocks in the Shetland Isles.

391 Description of Shetland Islands, p. 527, Edinburgh 1822, which I appreciate for the following depictions of rocks in the Shetland Isles.

392 Dr. Hibbert, from MSS. of Rev. George Low, of Fetlar.

392 Dr. Hibbert, from the manuscripts of Rev. George Low, of Fetlar.

393 Hibbert, p. 528.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Hibbert, p. 528.

394 Hibbert, p. 519.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Hibbert, p. 519.

395 Account of Erection of Bell Rock Lighthouse, p. 163.

395 Account of Building Bell Rock Lighthouse, p. 163.

396 Ed. Phil. Journ. vol. iii. p. 54, 1820.

396 Ed. Phil. Journ. vol. iii. p. 54, 1820.

397 Quart. Journ. of Sci. &c., No. xiii. N. S. March, 1830.

397 Quarterly Journal of Science, No. 13, New Series, March 1830.

398 Buist, Quart. Journ. of Agricult., No. xlv. p. 34, June, 1839.

398 Buist, Quart. Journ. of Agricult., No. xlv. p. 34, June, 1839.

399 Phillips's Geology of Yorkshire, p. 61.

399 Phillips's Geology of Yorkshire, p. 61.

400 Rivers, Mountains, and Sea-coast of Yorkshire p. 122, 1853, London.

400 Rivers, Mountains, and Coast of Yorkshire p. 122, 1853, London.

401 Arctic Zoology, vol. i. p. 10, Introduction.

401 Arctic Zoology, vol. i. p. 10, Introduction.

402 Phillips's Geol. of York. p. 60.

402 Phillips's Geology of York. p. 60.

403 Arct. Zool. vol. i. p. 13, Introd.

403 Arctic Zoology vol. 1, page 13, Introduction.

404 Taylor's Geology of East Norfolk, p. 32.

404 Taylor's Geology of East Norfolk, p. 32.

405 Ibid.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Same source.

406 De Beaumont, Géologie Pratique, p. 218.

406 De Beaumont, Practical Geology, p. 218.

407 Taylor's Geology of East Norfolk, p. 10.

407 Taylor's Geology of East Norfolk, p. 10.

408 From Mr. R. C. Taylor's Mem., see Phil. Mag., Oct. 1827, p. 297.

408 From Mr. R. C. Taylor's Memoir, see Phil. Mag., Oct. 1827, p. 297.

409 Consequences of the Deluge, Phys. Theol. Discourses.

409 Effects of the Flood, Phys. Theol. Discourses.

410 History of British Birds, vol. ii. p. 220 ed. 1821.

410 History of British Birds, vol. ii. p. 220 ed. 1821.

411 Tidal Harbor Commissioners' First Report, 1845, p. 176.

411 Tidal Harbor Commissioners' First Report, 1845, p. 176.

412 On authority of Dr. Mitchell, F. G. S.

412 According to Dr. Mitchell, F. G. S.

413 On the authority of W. Gunnell, Esq., and W. Richardson, Esq., F. G. S.

413 Based on the authority of W. Gunnell, Esq., and W. Richardson, Esq., F. G. S.

414 Vol. ii. New Ser. 1809, p. 801.

414 Vol. ii. New Ser. 1809, p. 801.

415 Geog. of Herod. vol. ii. p. 326.

415 Geography of Herodotus, vol. ii, p. 326.

416 Dodsley's Ann. Regist. 1772.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Dodsley's Annual Register 1772.

417 See J. B. Redman on Changes of S. E. Coast of England, Proceed. Instit. Civil Engin. vol. ii. 1851, 1852.

417 See J. B. Redman on Changes of the Southeast Coast of England, Proceedings of the Institution of Civil Engineers, vol. ii. 1851, 1852.

418 Stevenson, Ed. Phil Journ. No. v. p. 45, and Dr. Fitton, Geol. Trans. 2d series, vol. iv. plate 9.

418 Stevenson, Ed. Phil Journ. No. v. p. 45, and Dr. Fitton, Geol. Trans. 2nd series, vol. iv. plate 9.

419 On the authority of Mr. J. Meryon, of Rye.

419 According to Mr. J. Meryon from Rye.

420 Redman, ibid, see p. 315.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Redman, same source, see p. __A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_1__.

421 Edin. Journ. of Sci. No. xix. p. 56.

421 Edin. Journal of Science No. 19, p. 56.

422 Redman as cited, p. 315.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Redman cited, p. 315.

423 Webster, Geol. Trans. vol. ii. p. 192, 1st series.

423 Webster, Geol. Trans. vol. ii. p. 192, 1st series.

424 Mantell, Geology of Sussex, p. 293.

424 Mantell, Geology of Sussex, p. 293.

425 See Palmer on Shingle Beaches, Phil. Trans. 1834, p. 568.

425 Check out Palmer on Shingle Beaches, Phil. Trans. 1834, p. 568.

426 Groins are formed of piles and wooden planks, or of fagots staked down and are used either to break the force of the waves, or to retain the beach.

426 Groins are made of piles and wooden boards, or of bundled branches secured in place, and are used either to lessen the impact of the waves or to hold the beach in place.

427 Redman as cited, p. 315.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Redman mentioned, p. 315.

428 Rob. A. C. Austen on the Valley of the English Channel, Quart. Journ. G. S. vol. vi. p. 72.

428 Rob. A. C. Austen on the Valley of the English Channel, Quart. Journ. G. S. vol. vi. p. 72.

429 See Palmer on Motion of Shingle Beaches, Phil. Trans. 1834, p. 568; and Col. Sir W. Reid, Papers of Royal Engineers, 1838, vol ii. p. 128.

429 Check out Palmer on the Movement of Shingle Beaches, Phil. Trans. 1834, p. 568; and Col. Sir W. Reid, Papers of Royal Engineers, 1838, vol ii. p. 128.

430 De la Beche, Geolog. Manual, p. 82.

430 De la Beche, Geology Manual, p. 82.

431 According to the measurement of Carpenter of Lyme.

431 According to Carpenter of Lyme's measurements.

432 Rev. W. D. Conybeare, letter dated Axminster, Dec. 31, 1839.

432 Rev. W. D. Conybeare, letter dated Axminster, Dec. 31, 1839.

433 London, J. Murray, 1840.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ London, J. Murray, 1840.

434 Boase, Trans. Royal Geol. Soc. of Cornwall, vol. ii. p. 129.

434 Boase, Trans. Royal Geol. Soc. of Cornwall, vol. ii. p. 129.

435 Boase, ibid. vol. ii. p. 135.

435 Boase, same source, vol. ii, p. 135.

436 De la Beche's Report on the Geology of Devon, &c. chap. xiii.

436 De la Beche's Report on the Geology of Devon, etc. chap. xiii.

437 Geol. Trans. 1st series, vol. iii. p. 383.

437 Geol. Trans. 1st series, vol. iii. p. 383.

438 Boase, vol. ii. p. 130.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Boase, vol. 2, p. 130.

439 Stevenson, Jameson's Ed. New Phil. Journ. No. 8, p. 386.

439 Stevenson, Jameson's Ed. New Phil. Journ. No. 8, p. 386.

440 Camden, who cites Gyraldus; also Ray, "On the Deluge," Phys. Theol. p. 228.

440 Camden, who references Gyraldus; also Ray, "On the Deluge," Phys. Theol. p. 228.

441 Meyrick's Cardigan.

Meyrick's Cardigan.

442 Von Hoff, Geschichte, &c. vol. i. p. 49.

442 Von Hoff, History, etc. vol. i. p. 49.

443 E. de Beaumont, Géologie Pratique, vol. i. p. 316, and ibid. p. 260.

443 E. de Beaumont, Practical Geology, vol. i. p. 316, and ibid. p. 260.

444 Belpaire, Mém. de l'Acad. Roy. de Bruxelles, tom. x. 1837. Dumont, Bulletin of the same Soc. tom. v. p. 643.

444 Belpaire, Memoirs of the Royal Academy of Brussels, vol. x. 1837. Dumont, Bulletin of the same Society, vol. v. p. 643.

445 Von Hoff, vol. i. p. 364.

445 Von Hoff, vol. i. p. 364.

446 Quart. Journ. Geol. Soc. vol. iv. p. 32; Memoirs.

446 Quart. Journ. Geol. Soc. vol. iv. p. 32; Memoirs.

447 See examples in Von Hoff; vol. i. p. 73, who cites Pisansky.

447 See examples in Von Hoff; vol. i. p. 73, who references Pisansky.

448 Book vii. Cimbri.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Book 7. Cimbri.

449 Lib. iii. cap 3.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Book 3, chapter 3.

450 New Monthly Mag. vol. vi. p. 69.

450 New Monthly Mag. vol. vi. p. 69.

451 Von Hoff, vol. i. p. 96.

451 Von Hoff, vol. 1, p. 96.

452 Phil. Trans. 1833, p. 204.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Phil. Trans. 1833, p. 204.

453 See Lyell's Travels in North America, in 1842, vol. ii. p. 166. London, 1845.

453 See Lyell's Travels in North America, in 1842, vol. ii. p. 166. London, 1845.

454 Rennell, Phil. Trans. 1781.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Rennell, Phil. Trans. 1781.

455 MS. of Capt. Bayfield, R. N.

455 Manuscript of Captain Bayfield, Royal Navy.

456 Silliman's Journ. vol. xxxiv. p. 349.

456 Silliman's Journ. vol. xxxiv. p. 349.

457 Phil. Trans. 1829, part i. p. 29.

457 Phil. Trans. 1829, part i. p. 29.

458 Phil. Trans. 1724.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Philosopher's Transactions, 1724.

459 Bull. de la Soc. Géol de France,—Résumé, p. 72, 1832.

459 Bull. de la Soc. Géol de France,—Summary, p. 72, 1832.

460 Clarke's Travels in Europe, Asia, and Africa, vol. iii. pp. 340 and 363, 4th edition.

460 Clarke's Travels in Europe, Asia, and Africa, vol. iii. pp. 340 and 363, 4th edition.

461 Nouvelle Chronique de la Ville de Bayonne, pp. 113, 139: 1827.

461 New Chronicle of the City of Bayonne, pp. 113, 139: 1827.

462 Stevenson on bed of German Ocean, Ed. Phil. Journ. No. v. p. 44: 1820.

462 Stevenson on the bed of the German Ocean, Ed. Phil. Journ. No. v. p. 44: 1820.

463 Stevenson, ibid. p. 47: 1820.

463 Stevenson, same source, p. 47: 1820.

464 Robt. A. C. Austen, Quart. Journ. Geol. Soc. vol. vi. p. 76.

464 Robert A. C. Austen, Quarterly Journal of the Geological Society, volume 6, page 76.

465 Experiments to determine the Figure of the Earth, &c. p. 445.

465 Experiments to figure out the shape of the Earth, etc. p. 445.

466 Lochead on Nat. Hist. of Guiana, Edin. Trans. vol. iv.

466 Lochead on Nat. Hist. of Guiana, Edin. Trans. vol. iv.

467 On the authority of Mr. Faraday.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ From Mr. Faraday's authority.

468 On the authority of Mr. R. Phillips.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ According to Mr. R. Phillips.

469 See Von Buch's Description of Canary Islands (Paris, ed. 1836) for a valuable sketch of the principal volcanoes of the globe.

469 Check out Von Buch's Description of Canary Islands (Paris, ed. 1836) for a useful overview of the major volcanoes around the world.

470 Darwin, Geol. Trans. 2d series, vol. v. p. 612.

470 Darwin, Geological Transactions, 2nd series, volume 5, page 612.

471 Ibid. p. 606.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Same source, p. 606.

472 Bull. de la Soc. Géol. tom. vi. p. 55.

472 Bull. de la Soc. Géol. vol. vi. p. 55.

473 Bull. de la Soc. Géol. de France, tom. vi. p. 56.

473 Bull. de la Soc. Géol. de France, vol. vi, p. 56.

474 Caldeleugh, Phil. Trans. 1836, p. 27.

474 Caldeleugh, Phil. Trans. 1836, p. 27.

475 Comptes Rendus, 1849, vol. xxix. p. 531.

475 Comptes Rendus, 1849, vol. xxix. p. 531.

476 See map of volcanic lines in Von Buch's work on the Canaries.

476 Check out the map of volcanic lines in Von Buch's book on the Canaries.

477 Von Buch, ibid. p. 409.

477 Von Buch, same source, p. 409.

478 Darwin, Structure and Distrib. of Coral reefs, &c., London, 1842. In the subjoined map, fig. 39, I have copied with permission a small part of the valuable map accompanying this work.

478 Darwin, Structure and Distribution of Coral Reefs, etc., London, 1842. In the attached map, fig. 39, I have reproduced a small section of the valuable map that comes with this work, with permission.

479 Von Buch, Descrip. des Iles Canar. p. 450, who cites Erman and others.

479 Von Buch, Description of the Canary Islands, p. 450, who references Erman and others.

480 Paper read at meeting of Brit. Assoc. Southampton, Sept. 1846.

480 Paper presented at a meeting of the British Association in Southampton, September 1846.

481 Macclelland, Report on Coal and Min. Resources of India. Calcutta, 1838.

481 Macclelland, Report on Coal and Mineral Resources of India. Calcutta, 1838.

482 Geology of the American Exploring Expedition. See also Lyell's Manual, "Sandwich I. Volcanoes"—Index.

482 Geology of the American Exploring Expedition. See also Lyell's Manual, "Sandwich I. Volcanoes"—Index.

483 Strabo, ed Fal., p. 900.

483 Strabo, edited by Fal., p. 900.

484 Researches in Asia Minor, vol. ii. p. 39.

484 Studies in Asia Minor, vol. ii. p. 39.

485 Virlet, Bulletin de la Soc. Géol. de France, tom. iii. p. 109.

485 Virlet, Bulletin de la Soc. Géol. de France, vol. iii, p. 109.

486 Daubeny on Mount Vultur, Ashmolean Memoirs. Oxford, 1835.

486 Daubeny on Mount Vultur, Ashmolean Memoirs. Oxford, 1835.

487 Book v. ch. xlvi.—See letter of M. Virlet, Bulletin de la Soc. Géol. de France, tom. ii. p. 341.

487 Book v. ch. xlvi.—See letter from M. Virlet, Bulletin de la Soc. Géol. de France, tom. ii. p. 341.

488 See ch. 32, Cause of Volcanic Eruptions.

488 See ch. 32, Cause of Volcanic Eruptions.

489 Verneur, Journal des Voyages, tom. iv. p. 111. Von Hoff, vol. ii. p. 275.

489 Verneur, Journal of Travels, vol. iv, p. 111. Von Hoff, vol. ii, p. 275.

490 Lib. v.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Lib. v.

491 Nat. Hist. lib. iii. c. 6.

491 Nat. Hist. lib. iii. c. 6.

492 See Poulett Scrope, Geol. Trans. 2d series, vol. ii. pl. 34.

492 See Poulett Scrope, Geological Transactions, 2nd series, vol. ii, plate 34.

493 De Rerum Nat. vi. 740.—Forbes, on Bay of Naples, Edin. Journ. of Sci. No iii. new series, p. 87. Jan. 1830.

493 On the Nature of Things vi. 740.—Forbes, on the Bay of Naples, Edinburgh Journal of Science, No. iii, new series, p. 87. January 1830.

494 Humboldt, Voy. p. 317.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Humboldt, Voyage, p. 317.

495 Von Buch, Ueber einen vulcanischen Ausbruch auf der Insel Lanzerote.

495 Von Buch, About a volcanic eruption on the island of Lanzarote.

496 Haustæ aut obrutæ urbes.—Hist. lib. i.

496 Destroyed or buried cities.—Hist. book 1.

497 Hist. Rom. lib. lxvi.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Hist. Rom. vol. 66.

498 The earliest authority, says Mr. Forbes, given for this fact, appears to be Capaccio, quoted in the Terra Tremante of Bonito.—Edin. Journ. of Sci. &c. No. i. new series, p. 127. July, 1829.

498 The earliest source supporting this fact, according to Mr. Forbes, seems to be Capaccio, mentioned in the Terra Tremante by Bonito.—Edin. Journ. of Sci. &c. No. i. new series, p. 127. July, 1829.

499 Geol. Trans. second series, vol. ii. p. 346.

499 Geol. Trans. second series, vol. ii. p. 346.

500 Lib. vi. de Bello Neap. in Grævii Thesaur.

500 Book 6 of De Bello Neapolitano in Grævii Thesaurus.

501 Prodig. libel. c. cxiv.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Prodig. libel. c. 114.

502 This representation of the Phlegræan Fields is reduced from part of Plate xxxi. of Sir William Hamilton's great work "Campi Phlegræi." The faithfulness of his colored delineations of the scenery of that country cannot be too highly praised.

502 This depiction of the Phlegræan Fields is taken from Plate xxxi of Sir William Hamilton's acclaimed work "Campi Phlegræi." The accuracy of his colored illustrations of the landscape in that region is commendable.

503 Campi Phlegræi, p. 70.

Campi Flegrei, p. 70.

504 Campi Phlegræi, p. 77.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Phlegrean Fields, p. 77.

505 P. 347. Paris, 1836.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ P. 347. Paris, 1836.

506 "Magnus terræ tractus, qui inter radices montis, quem Barbarum incolæ appellant, et mare juxta Avernum jacet, sese erigere videbatur, et montis subitò nascentis figuram imitari. Eo ipso die horâ noctis II., iste terræ cumulus, aperto veluti ore, magno cum fremitu, magnos ignes evomuit; pumicesque, et lapides, cineresque."—Porzio, Opera Omnis, Medica, Phil., et Mathemat., in unum collecta, 1736, cited by Dufrénoy, Mém. pour servir à une Description Géologique de la France, tom. iv. p. 274.

506 "The great mass of land, which lies between the base of the mountain known as Barbarus and the sea near Avernus, appeared to rise up, mimicking the shape of a sudden mountain. On that very day, at two o'clock in the night, this mound of earth, as if with an open mouth, emitted a loud rumble and released great flames; along with it, there were chunks of pumice, stones, and ashes."—Porzio, Opera Omnis, Medica, Phil., et Mathemat., in unum collecta, 1736, cited by Dufrénoy, Mém. pour servir à une Description Géologique de la France, tom. iv. p. 274.

507 See Neues Jahr Buch for 1846, and a translation in the Quarterly Journ. of the Geol. Soc. for 1847, vol iii. p. 20, Memoirs.

507 See the New Year Book for 1846, and a translation in the Quarterly Journal of the Geological Society for 1847, vol iii. p. 20, Memoirs.

508 Mem. Roy. Acad. Nap. 1849.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Royal Academy of Naples 1849.

509 "Verum quod omnem superat admirationem, mons circum eam voraginem ex pummicibus et cincere plusquàm mille passuum altitudine unà nocte congestus aspicitur."

509 "But what truly surpasses all wonder is that the mountain surrounding that abyss made of pumice and ash rises more than a thousand paces high, gathered together in a single night."

510 Mém. de la Soc. Géol. de France, tom. ii. p. 91.

510 Memoirs of the Geological Society of France, vol. ii. p. 91.

511 Dufrénoy, Mem. pour servir, &c. p. 277.

511 Dufrénoy, Memoir for Serving, etc. p. 277.

512 Darwin's Volcanic Islands, 106, note.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Darwin's volcanic islands, 106, note.

513 Geology of the American Exploring Expedition, in 1838-1842, p. 354.

513 Geology of the American Exploring Expedition, from 1838 to 1842, p. 354.

514 Ibid. p. 328.

Ibid. p. 328.

515 See chap. 29.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ See chapter 29.

516 Hamilton (writing in 1770) says, "the new mountain produces as yet but a very slender vegetation."—Campi Phlegræi, p. 69. This remark was no longer applicable when I saw it, in 1828.

516 Hamilton (writing in 1770) says, "the new mountain produces as yet but a very slim vegetation."—Campi Phlegræi, p. 69. This comment was no longer relevant when I saw it in 1828.

517 Hamilton's Campi Phlegræi, folio, vol. i. p. 62; and Brieslak, Campanie, tome i. p. 186.

517 Hamilton's Campi Phlegræi, folio, vol. i. p. 62; and Brieslak, Campanie, tome i. p. 186.

518 Account of the Eruption of Vesuvius in October, 1822, by G. P. Scrope, Esq., Journ. of Sci. &c. vol. xv. p. 175.

518 A Report on the Eruption of Vesuvius in October, 1822, by G. P. Scrope, Esq., Journ. of Sci. &c. vol. xv. p. 175.

519 Mr. Forbes, Account of Mount Vesuvius, Edin. Journ. of Sci. No. xviii. p. 195. Oct. 1828.

519 Mr. Forbes, Account of Mount Vesuvius, Edin. Journ. of Sci. No. xviii. p. 195. Oct. 1828.

520 Ibid. p. 194.

Ibid. p. 194.

521 Monticelli and Covelli, Storia di Fenon. del Vesuv. en 1821-23.

521 Monticelli and Covelli, History of Phenomena of Vesuvius. in 1821-23.

522 Campi Phlegræi.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Phlegraean Fields.

523 Otter's Life of Dr. Clarke.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Otter's Life of Dr. Clarke.

524 Phil. Trans. 1846, p. 154.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Phil. Trans. 1846, p. 154.

525 Ibid. p. 148.

Ibid. p. 148.

526 Ibid. p. 241.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Same source, p. 241.

527 Bulletin de la Soc. Géol. de France, tom. vii. p. 43; and Illustrations of Vesuvius and Etna, p. 3.

527 Bulletin of the Geological Society of France, vol. vii, p. 43; and Illustrations of Vesuvius and Etna, p. 3.

528 Geognost. Beobachtungen, &c., p. 182. Berlin, 1839.

528 Geognost. Observations, &c., p. 182. Berlin, 1839.

529 Von Buch, Descrip. Phys. des Iles Canaries, p. 342. Paris, 1836.

529 Von Buch, Phys. Description of the Canary Islands, p. 342. Paris, 1836.

530 Vues Illust. de Phénom. Géol. Observ. sur le Vésuve et l'Etna. Berlin, 1837.

530 Illustrated Views of Geological Phenomena. Observations on Vesuvius and Etna. Berlin, 1837.

531 Ibid. p. 2.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Same source, p. 2.

532 2d edit. 1848, p. 216.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ 2nd edition. 1848, p. 216.

533 So called from travellers leaving their horses and mules there when they prepare to ascend the cone on foot.

533 Named because travelers leave their horses and mules there when they get ready to climb the cone on foot.

534 Dufrénoy, Mém. pour servir à une Descrip. Géol. de la France, tom. iv. p. 294.

534 Dufrénoy, Memoir to Contribute to a Geological Description of France, vol. iv. p. 294.

535 Descrip. Phys. des Iles Canaries, p. 344.

535 Physical Description of the Canary Islands, p. 344.

536 See Daubeny's Volcanoes, p. 400.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ See Daubeny's Volcanoes, p. 400.

537 Geol. of American Explor. Exped. p. 359, note. Mr. Dana informed me (Sept. 1852), that an angle of 60° instead of 30°, was given by mistake in his work.

537 Geol. of American Explor. Exped. p. 359, note. Mr. Dana told me (Sept. 1852) that an angle of 60° was mistakenly reported instead of 30° in his work.

538 Ibid. p. 354.

Ibid. p. 354.

539 Geol. Trans. 2d series, vol. ii. p. 341.

539 Geol. Trans. 2nd series, vol. 2, p. 341.

540 See a paper by the Author on "Craters of Denudation," Quart. Journ. Geol. Soc. 1850.

540 Check out a paper by the Author titled "Craters of Denudation," Quart. Journ. Geol. Soc. 1850.

541 Dufrénoy, Mém. pour servir, &c. tom. iv. p. 285.

541 Dufrénoy, Memoir for Reference, etc. vol. iv, p. 285.

542 Journal of Science, vol. xv. p. 177.

542 Journal of Science, vol. 15, p. 177.

543 Voy. dans la Campanie, tome i. p. 201.

543 Travel in Campania, vol. I, p. 201.

544 Mr. Forbes, Edin. Journ. of Sci. No. xviii. Oct. 1828.

544 Mr. Forbes, Edinburgh Journal of Science No. 18, October 1828.

545 Daubeny on Volcanoes, p. 169.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Daubeny on Volcanoes, p. 169.

546 Scrope, Geol. Trans. second series, vol. ii. p. 346.

546 Scrope, Geological Transactions, second series, volume 2, page 346.

547 Monticelli and Covelli, Prodrom. della Mineral. Vesuv.

547 Monticelli and Covelli, Prodrom. of Vesuvian Mineralogy.

548 The great eruption, in 1822, caused a covering only a few inches thick on Pompeii. Several feet are mentioned by Prof. J. D. Forbes.—Ed. Journ. of Science, No. xix. p. 181, Jan. 1829. But he must have measured in spots where it had drifted. The dust and ashes were five feet thick at the top of the crater, and decreased gradually to ten inches at Torre del Annunziata. The size and weight of the ejected fragments diminished very regularly in the same continuous stratum, as the distance from the centre of projection was greater.

548 The major eruption in 1822 only left a layer a few inches thick on Pompeii. Prof. J. D. Forbes mentioned several feet in the Ed. Journ. of Science, No. xix. p. 181, Jan. 1829. However, he must have measured in areas where it had drifted. The dust and ashes were five feet thick at the top of the crater and gradually decreased to ten inches at Torre del Annunziata. The size and weight of the ejected fragments decreased consistently in the same continuous layer as the distance from the center of projection increased.

549 Forbes, Ed. Journ. of Sci. No. xix. p. 130, Jan. 1829.

549 Forbes, Ed. Journ. of Sci. No. xix. p. 130, Jan. 1829.

550 Scrope, Geol. Trans. second series, vol. ii. p. 346.

550 Scrope, Geological Transactions, second series, volume 2, page 346.

551 Napoli, 1816.

Naples, 1816.

552 Not a few of the organic bodies, called by Ehrenberg "infusoria," such as Galionella and Bacillaria, have been recently claimed by many botanists as belonging to the vegetable kingdom, and are referred to the classes called Diatomaceæ and Desmidiæ.

552 Several of the organisms that Ehrenberg referred to as "infusoria," like Galionella and Bacillaria, have recently been identified by many botanists as part of the plant kingdom and are classified under the groups Diatomaceae and Desmidiaceae.

553 See Ehrenberg, Proceedings (Berichte) of the Royal Acad. of Sci. Berlin, 1844, 1845, and an excellent abstract of his papers by Mr. Ansted in the Quart. Journ. of the Geol. Soc. London, No. 7, Aug. 1846. In regard to marine infusoria found in volcanic tuff; it is well known that on the shores of the island of Cephalonia in the Mediterranean (Proceedings, Geol. Soc. vol. ii. p. 220), there is a cavity in the rock, into which the sea has been flowing for ages, and many others doubtless exist in the leaky bottom of the ocean. The marine current has been rushing in for many years, and as the infusoria inhabiting the waters of the Mediterranean are exceedingly abundant, a vast store of their cases may accumulate in submarine caverns (the water, perhaps, being converted into steam, and so escaping upwards), and they may then be cast up again to furnish the materials of volcanic tuff, should an eruption occur like that which produced Graham Island, off the coast of Sicily, in 1831.

553 See Ehrenberg, Proceedings (Berichte) of the Royal Acad. of Sci. Berlin, 1844, 1845, and a great summary of his papers by Mr. Ansted in the Quart. Journ. of the Geol. Soc. London, No. 7, Aug. 1846. Regarding marine microorganisms found in volcanic tuff, it’s well known that there’s a cavity in the rocks on the shores of the island of Cephalonia in the Mediterranean (Proceedings, Geol. Soc. vol. ii. p. 220) where the sea has been flowing for ages, and many more are likely hidden in the porous ocean floor. The marine current has been rushing in for many years, and since the microorganisms living in the Mediterranean waters are extremely abundant, a massive accumulation of their shells could build up in underwater caves (the water might even turn into steam and rise), and then these shells could be brought back up to contribute to the volcanic tuff if an eruption occurs, similar to what happened with Graham Island off the coast of Sicily in 1831.

554 Hamilton, Observ. on Mount Vesuvius, p. 94. London, 1774.

554 Hamilton, Observations on Mount Vesuvius, p. 94. London, 1774.

555 Swinburne and Lalande. Paderni, Phil. Trans. 1758, vol. i. p. 619.

555 Swinburne and Lalande. Paderni, Phil. Trans. 1758, vol. i. p. 619.

556 Prof. J. D. Forbes, Edin. Journ. of Sci. No. xix. p. 130, Jan. 1829.

556 Prof. J. D. Forbes, Edinburgh Journal of Science, No. 19, p. 130, Jan. 1829.

557 In one of the manuscripts which was in the hands of the interpreters when I visited the museum in 1828, the author indulges in the speculation that all the Homeric personages were allegorical—that Agamemnon was the ether, Achilles the sun, Helen the earth, Paris the air, Hector the moon, &c.

557 In one of the manuscripts that the interpreters had when I visited the museum in 1828, the author speculates that all the characters in Homer’s works were allegorical—that Agamemnon represented the ether, Achilles symbolized the sun, Helen stood for the earth, Paris embodied the air, Hector represented the moon, etc.

558 Sir H. Davy, Consolations in Travel, p. 66.

558 Sir H. Davy, Consolations in Travel, p. 66.

559 Forsyth's Italy, vol. ii.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Forsyth's Italy, vol. 2.

560 In 1815, Captain Smyth ascertained, trigonometrically, that the height of Etna was 10,874 feet. The Catanians, disappointed that their mountain had lost nearly 2000 feet of the height assigned to it by Recupero, refused to acquiesce in the decision. Afterwards, in 1824, Sir J. Herschel, not being aware of Captain Smyth's conclusions, determined by careful barometrical measurement that the height was 10,872½ feet. This singular agreement of results so differently obtained was spoken of by Herschel as "a happy accident;" but Dr. Wollaston remarked that "it was one of those accidents which would not have happened to two fools."

560 In 1815, Captain Smyth determined, using trigonometry, that the height of Etna was 10,874 feet. The people of Catania, upset that their mountain had lost almost 2,000 feet from the height claimed by Recupero, refused to accept the decision. Then, in 1824, Sir J. Herschel, unaware of Captain Smyth's findings, found through careful barometric measurement that the height was 10,872½ feet. This unusual coincidence of results obtained through such different methods was referred to by Herschel as "a happy accident;" however, Dr. Wollaston commented that "it was one of those accidents that wouldn’t happen to two fools."

561 Book iii. at the end.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Book 3. at the end.

562 The hill which I have here introduced was called by my guide Vampolara, but the name given in the text is the nearest to this which I find in Gemmellaro's Catalogue of Minor Cones.

562 The hill I mentioned was called Vampolara by my guide, but the name in the text is the closest I found in Gemmellaro's Catalogue of Minor Cones.

563 Mém. pour servir, &c. tom. iv. p. 116.

563 Memoir for reference, etc. vol. iv. p. 116.

564 See Prof. J. D. Forbes, Phil. Trans. 1846, p. 155, on Velocity of Lava.

564 See Prof. J. D. Forbes, Phil. Trans. 1846, p. 155, on the speed of lava.

565 Ferrara, Descriz. dell' Etna, p. 108.

565 Ferrara, Description of Etna, p. 108.

566 Ferrara, Descriz. dell' Etna. Palermo, 1818.

566 Ferrara, Description of Etna. Palermo, 1818.

567 This view is taken from a sketch made by Mr. James Bridges, corrected after comparison with several sketches of my own.

567 This perspective is based on a drawing by Mr. James Bridges, revised after comparing it with several of my own sketches.

568 Scrope on Volcanoes, p. 153.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Scrope on Volcanoes, p. 153.

569 This drawing is part of a panoramic sketch which I made from the summit of the cone, December 1, 1828, when every part of Etna was free from clouds except the Val del Bove. The small cone, and the crater nearest the foreground, were among those formed during the eruptions of 1810 and 1811.

569 This drawing is part of a panoramic sketch I created from the top of the cone on December 1, 1828, when every part of Etna was clear except for the Val del Bove. The small cone and the crater closest to the foreground were among those formed during the eruptions of 1810 and 1811.

570 Scrope on Volcanoes, p. 102.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Scrope on Volcanoes, p. 102.

571 Ferara, Descriz. dell' Etna, p. 116.

571 Ferara, Description of Etna, p. 116.

572 Mr. Nasmyth, the inventor of the steam-hammer, has lately illustrated, by a very striking experiment, the non-conductibility of a thin layer of dry sand and clay. Into a caldron of iron one-fourth of an inch thick, lined with sand and clay five-eighths of an inch thick, he poured eight tons of melted iron at a white heat. After the fused metal had been twenty minutes in the caldron the palm of the hand could be applied to the outside without inconvenience, and after forty minutes there was not heat enough to singe writing-paper. This fact may help us to explain how strata in contact with dikes, or beds of fused matter, have sometimes escaped without perceptible alteration by heat.

572 Mr. Nasmyth, the inventor of the steam hammer, recently demonstrated, through a striking experiment, that a thin layer of dry sand and clay does not conduct heat. He poured eight tons of molten iron at a white heat into a one-fourth-inch thick iron caldron lined with sand and clay that was five-eighths of an inch thick. After the molten metal had been in the caldron for twenty minutes, a person could comfortably place their palm on the outside, and after forty minutes, there wasn't enough heat to scorch writing paper. This observation may help us understand why layers in contact with dikes or beds of molten material sometimes remain unchanged by heat.

573 Journ. of Roy. Geograph. Soc. vol. i. p. 64.

573 Journal of Royal Geographic Society vol. 1 p. 64.

574 Hoffman, Geognost. Beobachtungen, p. 701. Berlin, 1839.

574 Hoffman, Geognost. Observations, p. 701. Berlin, 1839.

575 Mém. pour servir, &c., tom. iv. Paris, 1838.

575 Memoir for Reference, etc., vol. iv. Paris, 1838.

576 Geognost. Beobachtungen, &c. Berlin, 1839.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Geognost. Observations, etc. Berlin, 1839.

577 De Beaumont, Mém. pour servir, &c. tom. iv. pp. 187, 188.

577 De Beaumont, Memoirs for Reference, vol. iv, pp. 187, 188.

578 Mém. pour servir, tom. iv. p. 149.

578 Memoir for Reference, vol. iv. p. 149.

579 P. 62, supra.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ p. 62, above.

580 See p. 366.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ See page 366.

581 On the Longevity of Trees, Bibliot. Univ., May, 1831.

581 On How Long Trees Live, University Library, May, 1831.

582 Sedgwick, Anniv. Address to Geol. Soc. p. 35. Feb. 1831.

582 Sedgwick, Anniversary Address to Geological Society p. 35. February 1831.

583 Von Hoff, vol. ii. p. 393.

583 Von Hoff, vol. ii. p. 393.

584 The first narrative of the eruption was drawn up by Stephenson, then Chief Justice in Iceland, appointed Commissioner by the King of Denmark for estimating the damage done to the country, that relief might be afforded to the sufferers. Henderson was enabled to correct some of the measurements given by Stephenson, of the depth, width, and length of the lava currents, by reference to the MS. of Mr. Paulson, who visited the tract in 1794, and examined the lava with attention. (Journal of a Residence in Iceland, &c. p. 229.) Some of the principal facts are also corroborated by Sir William Hooker, in his "Tour in Iceland," vol. ii. p. 128.

584 The first account of the eruption was written by Stephenson, who was the Chief Justice in Iceland and had been appointed by the King of Denmark to assess the damage to the country so that aid could be provided to those affected. Henderson was able to correct some of the measurements given by Stephenson regarding the depth, width, and length of the lava flows by consulting the manuscript of Mr. Paulson, who visited the area in 1794 and studied the lava closely. (Journal of a Residence in Iceland, &c. p. 229.) Some of the key facts are also supported by Sir William Hooker in his "Tour in Iceland," vol. ii. p. 128.

585 Henderson's Journal, &c. p. 228.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Henderson's Journal, etc. p. 228.

586 Jameson's Phil. Journ. vol. xxvi. p. 291.

586 Jameson's Phil. Journ. vol. 26, p. 291.

587 Tableau des Terrains qui composent l'Ecorce du Globe, p. 52. Paris, 1829.

587 Table of the Layers that Make Up the Earth's Crust, p. 52. Paris, 1829.

588 Daubeny on Volcanoes, p. 337.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Daubeny on Volcanoes, p. 337.

589 See Scrope on Volcanoes, p. 267.

589 See Scrope on Volcanoes, p. 267.

590 Leonhard and Bronn's Neues Jahrbuch, 1835, p. 36.

590 Leonhard and Bronn's New Year’s Journal, 1835, p. 36.

591 Van der Boon Mesch, de Incendiis Montium Javæ, &c. Lugd. Bat. 1826; and Official Report of the President, Baron Van der Capellen; also, Von Buch, Iles Canar. p. 424.

591 Van der Boon Mesch, de Incendiis Montium Javæ, &c. Lugd. Bat. 1826; and Official Report of the President, Baron Van der Capellen; also, Von Buch, Iles Canar. p. 424.

592 Journ. de Géol. tome i.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Journal of Geology Vol. 1.

593 In a former edition, I selected the name of Sciacca out of seven which had been proposed; but the Royal and Geographical Societies have now adopted Graham Island; a name given by Capt. Senhouse, R. N., the first who succeeded in landing on it. The seven rival names are Nerita, Ferdinanda, Hotham, Graham, Corrao, Sciacca, Julia. As the isle was visible for only about three months, this is an instance of a wanton multiplication of synonyms which has scarcely ever been outdone even in the annals of zoology and botany.

593 In a previous edition, I chose the name Sciacca from seven options that were suggested; however, the Royal and Geographical Societies have now decided on Graham Island, a name given by Captain Senhouse, R. N., who was the first to successfully land there. The seven competing names are Nerita, Ferdinanda, Hotham, Graham, Corrao, Sciacca, and Julia. Since the island was only visible for about three months, this is an example of an unnecessary increase in synonyms that is rarely seen, even in the history of zoology and botany.

594 Phil. Trans. 1832, p. 255.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Phil. Trans. 1832, p. 255.

595 Journ. of Roy. Geograph. Soc. 1830-31.

595 Journal of Royal Geographical Society 1830-31.

596 Phil. Trans. part. ii. 1832, reduced from drawings by Capt. Wodehouse, R. N.

596 Phil. Trans. part. ii. 1832, adapted from sketches by Capt. Wodehouse, R. N.

597 In the annexed sketch (fig. 60), drawn by M. Joinville, who accompanied M. C. Prevost, the beds seem to slope towards the centre of the crater; but I am informed by M. Prevost that these lines were not intended by the artist to represent the dip of the beds.

597 In the attached sketch (fig. 60), created by M. Joinville, who was with M. C. Prevost, the beds appear to slope towards the center of the crater; however, M. Prevost tells me that the artist didn't mean for these lines to show the slope of the beds.

598 See Memoir by M. C. Prevost, Ann. des Sci. Nat. tom. xxiv.

598 See Memoir by M. C. Prevost, Ann. des Sci. Nat. vol. xxiv.

599 Geol. of Fife and the Lothians, p. 41. Edin. 1839.

599 Geology of Fife and the Lothians, p. 41. Edinburgh, 1839.

600 Phil. Trans. 1832, p. 243.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Phil. Trans. 1832, p. 243.

601 Ibid. p. 249.

Ibid. p. 249.

602 Darwin's Volcanic Islands, p. 92.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Darwin's Volcanic Islands, p. 92.

603 Ibid. p. 6.

Ibid. p. 6.

604 This account was principally derived by Von Buch from the MS. of Don Andrea Lorenzo Curbeto, curate of Yaira, the point where the eruption began.—Ueber einen vulcanischen Ausbruch auf der Insel Lanzerote.

604 This account mainly came from Von Buch’s manuscript by Don Andrea Lorenzo Curbeto, the curate of Yaira, the location where the eruption started.—On a volcanic eruption on the island of Lanzarote.

605 Férussac, Bulletin des Sci. Nat. tome v. p. 45: 1825.

605 Férussac, Bulletin des Sci. Nat. vol. v, p. 45: 1825.

606 Comptes Rendus Acad. Sci. Paris, Juin, 1846.

606 Proceedings of the French Academy of Sciences, June, 1846.

607 Virlet, Bull. de la Soc. Géol. de France, tom. iii. p. 103.

607 Virlet, Bulletin of the Geological Society of France, vol. iii, p. 103.

608 Phil. Trans. No. 332.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Phil. Trans. No. 332.

609 E. Forbes, Brit. Association, Report for 1843.

609 E. Forbes, British Association, Report for 1843.

610 See a paper read to the Geographical Society in 1849.

610 See a paper presented to the Geographical Society in 1849.

611 Bull. de la Soc. Géol. de France, tome iii.

611 Bull. de la Soc. Géol. de France, vol. III.

612 Virlet, Bull. de la Soc. Géol. de France, tome iii. p. 103.

612 Virlet, Bulletin of the Geological Society of France, volume iii, page 103.

613 Poggendorf's Annalen, 1836, p. 183.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Poggendorf's Annalen, 1836, p. 183.

614 See Admiralty Chart, with views and sections, 1842.

614 Refer to the Admiralty Chart, including views and sections, 1842.

615 For height of cone and references, see Buist, Volcanoes of India, Trans. Bombay Geol. Soc. vol. x. p. 143.

615 For the height of the cone and references, see Buist, Volcanoes of India, Trans. Bombay Geol. Soc. vol. x. p. 143.

616 Humboldt's Cosmos.

Humboldt's Cosmos.

617 Daubeny, Volcanoes, p. 267.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Daubeny, Volcanoes, p. 267.

618 See Buist, Volcanoes of India, Trans. Bombay Geol. Soc. vol. x. p. 154, and Captain Robertson, Journ. of Roy. Asiat. Soc. 1850.

618 See Buist, Volcanoes of India, Trans. Bombay Geol. Soc. vol. x. p. 154, and Captain Robertson, Journ. of Roy. Asiat. Soc. 1850.

619 See Glossary.

See Glossary.

620 Bunsen, Volcanic Rocks of Iceland.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Bunsen, Iceland's Volcanic Rocks.

621 Bulletin de la Soc. Géol. de France, tom. ii. p. 206.

621 Bulletin of the Geological Society of France, vol. ii, p. 206.

622 Since the publication of the first edition of this work, numerous accounts of recent earthquakes have been published; but as they do not illustrate any new principle, I cannot insert them, as they would enlarge too much the size of my work. The late Von Hoff published from time to time, in Poggendorf's Annalen, lists of earthquakes which happened between 1821 and 1836; and, by consulting these, the reader will perceive that every month is signalized by one or many convulsions in some part of the globe. See also Mallet's Dynamics of Earthquakes, Trans. Roy. Irish Acad. 1846; and "Earthquakes," Admiralty Manual, 1849; also Hopkins' Report, Brit. Assoc. 1847-8.

622 Since the first edition of this work was published, many reports of recent earthquakes have come out; however, since they don't introduce any new principles, I can't include them because they would significantly increase the size of my book. The late Von Hoff published lists of earthquakes that occurred between 1821 and 1836 from time to time in Poggendorf's Annalen; by looking at these, readers will see that each month is marked by one or more tremors in different parts of the world. Also refer to Mallet's Dynamics of Earthquakes, Trans. Roy. Irish Acad. 1846; and "Earthquakes," Admiralty Manual, 1849; as well as Hopkins' Report, Brit. Assoc. 1847-8.

623 Darwin, Geol. Proceedings, vol. ii. p. 658.

623 Darwin, Geological Proceedings, vol. 2, p. 658.

624 Dumoulin, Comptes Rendus de l'Acad. des Sci. Oct. 1838, p. 706.

624 Dumoulin, Proceedings of the Academy of Sciences, Oct. 1838, p. 706.

625 Phil. Trans. 1836, p. 21.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Phil. Trans. 1836, p. 21.

626 Phil. Trans. 1826.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Phil. Trans. 1826.

627 Darwin's Journ. of Travels in South America, Voyage of Beagle, p. 372.

627 Darwin's Journal of Travels in South America, Voyage of the Beagle, p. 372.

628 Biblioth. Univ. Oct. 1828, p. 157.

628 Biblioth. Univ. Oct. 1828, p. 157.

629 Phil. Mag. July 1828, p. 37.

629 Phil. Mag. July 1828, p. 37.

630 Geol. Trans. vol. i. 2d ser., and Journ. of Sci. 1824, vol. xvii. p. 40.

630 Geol. Trans. vol. i. 2nd ser., and Journ. of Sci. 1824, vol. xvii. p. 40.

631 Geol. Trans, vol. i. 2d ser. p. 415.

631 Geological Transactions, vol. 1, 2nd series, p. 415.

632 Journ. of Sci. vol. xvii. p. 42.

632 Journal of Science vol. 17 p. 42.

633 Reise um die Erde; and see Dr. Meyen's letter cited Foreign Quart. Rev. No. 33, p. 13, 1836.

633 Journey Around the World; and check out Dr. Meyen's letter referenced in the Foreign Quart. Rev. No. 33, p. 13, 1836.

634 Geol. Soc. Proceedings, No. xl. p. 179, Feb. 1835.

634 Geological Society Proceedings, No. 40, p. 179, February 1835.

635 Proceed. Geol. Soc. vol. ii. p. 447.

635 Go ahead. Geol. Soc. vol. ii. p. 447.

636 Geol. Trans. vol. i. 2d ser. p. 415.

636 Geol. Trans. vol. i. 2d ser. p. 415.

637 Journal of Science, vol. xvii. pp. 40, 45.

637 Journal of Science, vol. 17, pp. 40, 45.

638 See Asiatic Journal, vol. i.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ See Asiatic Journal, vol. 1.

639 Macmurdo Ed. Phil. Journ. iv. 106.

639 Macmurdo Ed. Phil. Journ. iv. 106.

640 I was indebted to my friend the late Sir Alexander Burnes for the accompanying sketch (fig. 72) of the fort of Sindree, as it appeared eleven years before the earthquake.

640 I owe my friend the late Sir Alexander Burnes for the attached sketch (fig. 72) of the Sindree fort, as it looked eleven years before the earthquake.

641 This Memoir is now in the Library of the Royal Asiatic Society of London.

641 This memoir is currently in the library of the Royal Asiatic Society of London.

642 Several particulars not given in the earlier edition were afterwards obtained by me from personal communication with Sir A. Burnes in London.

642 I later got several details that weren't included in the earlier edition through personal conversations with Sir A. Burnes in London.

643 Capt. Burnes' Account.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Captain Burnes' Account.

644 Capt. Macmurdo's Memoir, Ed. Phil. Journ. vol. iv. p. 106.

644 Capt. Macmurdo's Memoir, Ed. Phil. Journ. vol. iv. p. 106.

645 Quart. Geol. Journ. vol. ii. p. 103.

645 Quart. Geol. Journ. vol. ii. p. 103.

646 MS. of J. Crawfurd, Esq.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Manuscript by J. Crawfurd, Esq.

647 Raffles' Java, vol. i. p. 28.

647 Raffles' Java, vol. i. p. 28.

648 Raffles' Hist, of Java, vol. i. p. 25. Ed. Phil Journ. vol. iii. p. 389.

648 Raffles' Hist, of Java, vol. 1, p. 25. Ed. Phil Journ. vol. 3, p. 389.

649 Life and Services of Sir Stamford Raffles, p. 241. London, 1830.

649 Life and Services of Sir Stamford Raffles, p. 241. London, 1830.

650 Humboldt's Pers. Nar. vol. iv. p. 12; and Ed. Phil. Journ. vol. i. p. 272: 1819.

650 Humboldt's Personal Narrative, vol. iv, p. 12; and Edinburgh Philosophical Journal, vol. i, p. 272: 1819.

651 Cramer's Navigator, p. 243. Pittsburgh, 1821.

651 Cramer's Navigator, p. 243. Pittsburgh, 1821.

652 Long's Exped. to the Rocky Mountains, vol. iii. p. 184.

652 Long's Expedition to the Rocky Mountains, vol. iii. p. 184.

653 Silliman's Journ. Jan. 1829.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Silliman's Journal, Jan. 1829.

654 See Lyell's Second Visit to the United States, ch. xxxiii.

654 See Lyell's Second Visit to the United States, ch. 33.

655 Bemerkungen auf einer Reise um die Welt. bd. ii. s. 209.

655 Observations on a journey around the world. vol. ii. p. 209.

656 Neue Allgem. Geogr. Ephemer. bd. iii. s. 348.

656 New General Geography Ephemeris vol. iii, p. 348.

657 Cavanilles, Journ. de Phys. tome xlix. p. 230. Gilbert's Annalen, bd. vi. Humboldt's Voy. p. 317.

657 Cavanilles, Journal of Physics, Volume 49, page 230. Gilbert's Annals, Volume 6. Humboldt's Voyage, page 317.

658 Humboldt's Voy., Relat. Hist., part. i. p. 309.

658 Humboldt's Travels, Historical Account, part. i. p. 309.

659 Macgregor's Travels in America.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Macgregor's Travels in the U.S.

660 Humboldt's Voy., Relat. Hist., part. ii. p. 632.

660 Humboldt's Voy., Relat. Hist., part. ii. p. 632.

661 Ferrara, Camp. fl., p. 51.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Ferrara, Camp. fl., p. 51.

662 Batav. Trans, vol. viii. p. 141.

662 Batav. Trans, vol. viii. p. 141.

663 Istoria de'Tremuoti della Calabria del 1783.

663 History of the Earthquake in Calabria of 1783.

664 Descriz de'Tremuoti Accad. nelle Calabria nel 1783. Napoli, 1784.

664 Description of the Earthquakes that Occurred in Calabria in 1783. Naples, 1784.

665 Istoria de' Fenomeni del Tremoto, &c., nell' An. 1783, posta in luce dalla Real. Accad., &c. di Nap. Napoli, 1783, fol.

665 History of the Earthquake Phenomena, etc., in the year 1783, published by the Royal Academy of Naples. Naples, 1783, fol.

666 Dissertation on the Calabrian Earthquake, &c., translated in Pinkerton's Voyages and Travels, vol. v.

666 A Dissertation on the Calabrian Earthquake, etc., translated in Pinkerton's Voyages and Travels, vol. v.

667 Proceed. Roy. Irish Acad. 1846, p. 26.

667 Go ahead. Roy. Irish Acad. 1846, p. 26.

668 Journal of a Naturalist, p. 376, and ii. ib. 308.

668 Journal of a Naturalist, p. 376, and ii. ib. 308.

669 Proceedings Roy. Irish Acad. 1846, pp. 14-16.

669 Proceedings Roy. Irish Acad. 1846, pp. 14-16.

670 See Mr. Mallet's attempt to controvert this view, p. 32 ibid.

670 See Mr. Mallet's effort to challenge this perspective, p. 32 ibid.

671 Phil. Trans. vol. lxxiii. p. 180.

671 Phil. Trans. vol. 73. p. 180.

672 Pinkerton's Voyages and Travels, vol. v. as cited above, p. 455, note.

672 Pinkerton's Voyages and Travels, vol. v. as cited above, p. 455, note.

673 Dolomieu, ibid.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Dolomieu, same source.

674 Sir H. Davy's Consolations in Travel, p. 246.

674 Sir H. Davy's Consolations in Travel, p. 246.

675 Dr. Horsfield, Batav. Trans. vol. viii. p. 26. Dr. H. informs me that he has seen this truncated mountain; and, though he did not ascend it, he has conversed with those who have examined it. Raffles' account (History of Java, vol. i.) is derived from Horsfield.

675 Dr. Horsfield, Batav. Trans. vol. viii. p. 26. Dr. H. tells me that he has seen this cut-off mountain; and, although he didn’t climb it, he has talked with people who have looked at it. Raffles' description (History of Java, vol. i.) is based on Horsfield.

676 Essai sur l'Hist. Nat. de l'Isle de St. Domingue. Paris, 1776.

676 Essay on the Natural History of the Isle of St. Domingue. Paris, 1776.

677 Hist. de l'Acad. des Sciences. 1752, Paris.

677 History of the Academy of Sciences. 1752, Paris.

678 M'Clelland's Report on Min. Resources of India: 1838, Calcutta. For other particulars, see Phil. Trans. vol. liii.

678 M'Clelland's Report on Mineral Resources of India: 1838, Calcutta. For more details, see Phil. Trans. vol. liii.

679 Journ. Asiat. Soc. Bengal, vol. x. pp. 351, 433.

679 Journ. Asiat. Soc. Bengal, vol. x. pp. 351, 433.

680 Hist. and Philos. of Earthquakes, p. 317.

680 History and Philosophy of Earthquakes, p. 317.

681 Cosmos, vol. i.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Universe, vol. i.

682 Rev. C. Davy's Letters, vol. ii. Letter ii. p. 12, who was at Lisbon at the time, and ascertained that the boats and vessels said to have been swallowed were missing.

682 Rev. C. Davy's Letters, vol. ii. Letter ii. p. 12, who was in Lisbon at the time, confirmed that the boats and ships reported to be lost were indeed missing.

683 On the Formation of the Earth, p. 55.

683 On the Formation of the Earth, p. 55.

684 Geol. Soc. Proceedings, No. 60, p. 36. 1838.

684 Geol. Soc. Proceedings, No. 60, p. 36. 1838.

685 Michell on Earthquakes, Phil. Trans. vol. li. p. 566. 1760.

685 Michell on Earthquakes, Phil. Trans. vol. li. p. 566. 1760.

686 Michell, Phil. Trans. vol. li. p. 614.

686 Michell, Phil. Trans. vol. 51. p. 614.

687 Quarterly Review, No. lxxxvi. p. 459.

687 Quarterly Review, No. 86, p. 459.

688 Darwin's Travels in South America, &c., 1832 to 1836. Voyage of H. M. S. Beagle, vol. iii. p. 377.

688 Darwin's Travels in South America, etc., 1832 to 1836. Voyage of H. M. S. Beagle, vol. iii. p. 377.

689 Ann. de Ch. et de Ph., tom. xxii. p. 428.

689 Ann. de Ch. et de Ph., vol. 22, p. 428.

690 Mallet, Proceed. Roy. Irish Acad. 1846.

690 Mallet, Proceed. Roy. Irish Acad. 1846.

691 See Father Acosta's work; and Sir Woodbine Parish, Geol. Soc. Proceedings, vol. ii. p. 215.

691 Check out Father Acosta's work and Sir Woodbine Parish, Geological Society Proceedings, vol. ii. p. 215.

692 Molina, Hist. of Chili, vol. ii.

692 Molina, History of Chile, vol. ii.

693 Captain Belcher has shown me these shells, and the collection has been examined by Mr. Broderip.

693 Captain Belcher has shown me these shells, and Mr. Broderip has looked over the collection.

694 Ulloa's Voyage to South America, vol. ii. book viii. ch. vi.

694 Ulloa's Journey to South America, vol. ii. book viii. ch. vi.

695 Ibid. vol. ii. book vii. ch. vii.

695 Same source, vol. ii, book vii, ch. vii.

696 Ulloa's Voyage, vol. ii. p. 82.

696 Ulloa's Voyage, vol. 2, p. 82.

697 Wafer, cited by Sir W. Parish, Geol. Soc. Proceedings, vol. ii. p. 215.

697 Wafer, mentioned by Sir W. Parish, Geological Society Proceedings, vol. ii. p. 215.

698 Hist. of America, decad. iii. book xi. ch. i.

698 History of America, decade three, book eleven, chapter one.

699 Darwin's Journal, p. 451.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Darwin's Journal, p. 451.

700 Ibid. p. 413.

Ibid. p. 413.

701 Misspelt "Sales" in Hooke's Account.

Misspelled "Sales" in Hooke's Account.

702 Hooke's Posthumous Works, p. 437. 1705.

702 Hooke's Posthumous Works, p. 437. 1705.

703 Phil. Trans. 1700.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Philos. Trans. 1700.

704 Humboldt, Atl. Pit. p. 106.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Humboldt, Atl. Pit. p. 106.

705 Phil. Trans. 1693-4.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Phil. Trans. 1693-4.

706 Phil. Trans. 1693.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Phil. Trans. 1693.

707 Manual of Geol. p. 133, second edition.

707 Manual of Geol. p. 133, second edition.

708 Vol. i. p. 235, 8vo ed. 3 vols. 1801.

708 Vol. 1, p. 235, 8vo edition, 3 volumes, 1801.

709 Letter to the Author, May, 1838.

709 Letter to the Author, May, 1838.

710 Phil. Trans. 1694.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Phil. Trans. 1694.

711 This view of the temple (substituted for one by A. de Jorio, given in the earlier editions) has been reduced from part of a beautiful colored drawing taken in 1836, with the aid of the camera lucida, by Mr. l'Anson to illustrate a paper by Mr. Babbage on the temple, read March, 1834, and published in the Quart. Journ. of the Geol. Soc. of London, vol. iii. 1847.

711 This view of the temple (replacing one by A. de Jorio that appeared in earlier editions) has been scaled down from a stunning colored drawing made in 1836, using a camera lucida, by Mr. l'Anson to accompany a paper by Mr. Babbage on the temple, presented in March 1834, and published in the Quart. Journ. of the Geol. Soc. of London, vol. iii. 1847.

712 Mr. Babbage examined this spot in company with Sir Edmund Head in June, 1828, and has shown me numerous specimens of the shells collected there, and in the Temple of Serapis.

712 Mr. Babbage explored this location with Sir Edmund Head in June 1828 and has shared with me many examples of the shells collected there, as well as from the Temple of Serapis.

713 This view is taken from Sir W. Hamilton, Campi Phlegræi, plate 26.

713 This perspective comes from Sir W. Hamilton's Campi Phlegræi, plate 26.

714 This spot here indicated on the summit of the cliff is that from which Hamilton's view, plate 26, Campi Phlegræi (reduced in fig. 88, p. 509) is taken, and on which, he says, Cicero's villa, called the Academia, anciently stood.

714 This location shown at the top of the cliff is where Hamilton's view, plate 26, Campi Phlegræi (reduced in fig. 88, p. 509) is taken from, and it is where he notes that Cicero's villa, known as the Academia, used to be situated.

715 On the authority of Captain W. H. Smyth, R. N.

715 Based on the authority of Captain W. H. Smyth, R. N.

716 Dissertazione sulla Sagra Archittetura degli Antichi.

716 Dissertation on the Sacred Architecture of the Ancients.

717 This appears from the measurement of Captain Basil Hall, R. N., Proceedings of Geol. Soc., No. 38, p. 114; see also Patchwork, by the same author, vol. iii. p. 158. The fact of the three standing columns having been each formed out of a single stone was first pointed out to me by Mr. James Hall, and is important, as helping to explain why they were not shaken down.

717 This is evident from the measurements taken by Captain Basil Hall, R. N., in the Proceedings of the Geol. Soc., No. 38, p. 114; also see Patchwork, by the same author, vol. iii. p. 158. The observation that each of the three standing columns was carved from a single stone was initially brought to my attention by Mr. James Hall, and it's significant because it helps clarify why they remained standing without being toppled.

718 Modiola lithophaga, Lam. Mytilus lithophagus, Linn.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Modiola lithophaga, Lam. Mytilus lithophagus, Linn.

719 Serpula contortuplicata, Linn., and Vermilia triquetra, Lam. These species, as well as the Lithodomus, are now inhabitants of the neighboring sea.

719 Serpula contortuplicata, Linn., and Vermilia triquetra, Lam. These species, along with Lithodomus, currently live in the nearby sea.

720 Brieslak, Voy. dans la Campanie, tom. ii. p. 167.

720 Brieslak, Voyage in Campania, vol. ii. p. 167.

721 Ed. Journ. of Science, new series, No. II. p. 281.

721 Ed. Journal of Science, new series, No. II, p. 281.

722 Sul Tempio di Serap. ch. viii.

722 The Temple of Serapis. ch. viii.

723 Tavola Metrica Chronologica, &c. Napoli, 1838. Mr. Smith, of Jordan Hill, writing in 1847, estimated the rate of subsidence, at that period, at one inch annually. Quart. Journ. Geol. Soc. vol. iii. p. 237.

723 Chronological Metric Table, etc. Naples, 1838. Mr. Smith, from Jordan Hill, writing in 1847, estimated the subsidence rate at that time to be one inch per year. Quart. Journ. Geol. Soc. vol. iii. p. 237.

724 Voy. dans la Campanie, tome ii. p. 162.

724 Travel in the Countryside, volume ii, page 162.

725 Mr. Forbes, Physical Notices of the Bay of Naples. Ed. Journ. of Sci., No. II., new series, p. 280. October, 1829. When I visited Puzzuoli, and arrived at the above conclusions, I knew nothing of Mr. Forbes's observations, which I first saw on my return to England the year following.

725 Mr. Forbes, Physical Notices of the Bay of Naples. Ed. Journ. of Sci., No. II., new series, p. 280. October, 1829. When I visited Puzzuoli and came to the conclusions mentioned above, I was unaware of Mr. Forbes's observations, which I only saw when I returned to England the following year.

726 Quart. Journ. Geol. Soc. 1847, vol. iii. p. 203.

726 Quart. Journ. Geol. Soc. 1847, vol. iii. p. 203.

727 Nuove Ricerche sul Temp. di Serap.

727 New Research on the Temple of Serapis.

728 The Swedish measure scarcely differs from ours; the foot being divided into twelve inches, and being less than ours by three-eighths of an inch only.

728 The Swedish measurement is almost the same as ours; the foot is divided into twelve inches and is only three-eighths of an inch shorter than ours.

729 For a full account of the Celsian controversy, we may refer our readers to Von Hoff, Geschichte, &c. vol. i. p. 439.

729 For a complete account of the Celsian controversy, we can direct our readers to Von Hoff, Geschichte, &c. vol. i. p. 439.

730 Piteo, Luleo, and Obo are spelt, in many English maps, Pitea, Lulea, Åbo; the a is not sounded in the Swedish diphthong ao or å.

730 Piteo, Luleo, and Obo are written in many English maps as Pitea, Lulea, Åbo; the a is not pronounced in the Swedish diphthong ao or å.

731 Sect. 393.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Sec. 393.

732 Sect. 398.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Sec. 398.

733 Transl. of his Travels, p. 387.

733 Translated version of his Travels, p. 387.

734 In the earlier editions I expressed many doubts as to the validity of the proofs of a gradual rise of land in Sweden. A detailed statement of the observations which I made in 1834, and which led me to change my opinion, will be found in the Philosophical Transactions for 1835, part i.

734 In the earlier editions, I had many doubts about the proof that land in Sweden is gradually rising. A detailed account of the observations I made in 1834, which changed my mind, can be found in the Philosophical Transactions for 1835, part i.

735 See Professor Johnston's Paper, Ed. New Phil. Journ. No. 29, July 1833; and my remarks, Phil. Trans. 1835, p. 12.

735 See Professor Johnston's Paper, Ed. New Phil. Journ. No. 29, July 1833; and my comments, Phil. Trans. 1835, p. 12.

736 See p. 522; also chap. 15, supra.

736 See p. 522; also chap. 15, above.

737 See a paper by the Author, Phil. Trans. 1835, part i.

737 Check out a paper by the Author, Phil. Trans. 1835, part i.

738 See my paper before referred to, Phil. Trans. 1885, part i. p. 8, 9. Attempts have been since made to explain away the position of this hut, by conjecturing that a more recent trench had been previously dug here, which had become filled up in time by sand drifted by the wind. The engineers who superintended the works in 1819, and with whom I conversed, had considered every hypothesis of the kind, but could not so explain the facts.

738 Check out my earlier paper, Phil. Trans. 1885, part i. p. 8, 9. Since then, some have tried to dismiss the location of this hut by suggesting that a newer trench was dug here before, which eventually got filled in by sand blown in by the wind. The engineers who oversaw the work in 1819, and whom I spoke with, considered all such theories but couldn’t explain the facts that way.

739 Quart. Journ. of Geol. Soc. No. 4, p. 534. M. Bravais' observations were verified in 1849 by Mr. R. Chambers in his "Tracings of N. of Europe," p. 208.

739 Quart. Journ. of Geol. Soc. No. 4, p. 534. M. Bravais' observations were confirmed in 1849 by Mr. R. Chambers in his "Tracings of N. of Europe," p. 208.

740 See Proceedings of Geol. Soc. No. 42, p. 208. I also conversed with Dr. Pingel on the subject at Copenhagen in 1834.

740 See Proceedings of Geol. Soc. No. 42, p. 208. I also talked with Dr. Pingel about this topic in Copenhagen in 1834.

741 Keilhau, Bulletin de la Soc. Géol de France, tom. vii. p. 18.

741 Keilhau, Bulletin de la Soc. Géol de France, vol. 7, p. 18.

742 Illust. of Hutt. Theory, § 435-443.

742 Illust. of Hutt. Theory, § 435-443.

743 Herschel's Astronomy, chap. iii.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Herschel's Astronomy, chapter 3.

744 See Hennessy, On Changes in Earth's Figure, &c. Journ. Geol. Soc. Dublin, 1849; and Proc. Roy. Irish Acad. vol. iv. p. 337.

744 See Hennessy, On Changes in Earth's Figure, &c. Journ. Geol. Soc. Dublin, 1849; and Proc. Roy. Irish Acad. vol. iv. p. 337.

745 Young's Lectures, and Mrs. Somerville's Connection of the Physical Sciences, p. 90.

745 Young's Lectures, and Mrs. Somerville's Connection of the Physical Sciences, p. 90.

746 Phil. Trans. 1839, and Researches in Physical Geology, 1st, 2d, and 3d series, London, 1839-1842; also on Phenomena and Theory of Volcanoes, Report Brit. Assoc. 1847.

746 Phil. Trans. 1839, and Researches in Physical Geology, 1st, 2nd, and 3rd series, London, 1839-1842; also on Phenomena and Theory of Volcanoes, Report Brit. Assoc. 1847.

747 Ed. Journ. of Sci. April, 1832.

747 Ed. Journ. of Sci. April, 1832.

748 Cordier, Mém. de l'Instit. tom. vii.

748 Cordier, Memoirs of the Institute, vol. vii.

749 Pog. Ann. tom. xv. p. 159.

749 Pog. Ann. vol. xv. p. 159.

750 See M. Cordier's Memoir on the Temperature of the Interior of the Earth, read to the Academy of Sciences, 4th June, 1827.—Edin. New Phil. Journal, No. viii. p. 273.

750 See M. Cordier's Memoir on the Temperature of the Earth's Interior, presented to the Academy of Sciences on June 4, 1827.—Edin. New Phil. Journal, No. viii. p. 273.

751 Cordier, Mém. de l'Instit. tom. vii.

751 Cordier, Memoirs of the Institute, vol. VII.

752 Phil. Mag. and Ann. Feb. 1830.

752 Phil. Mag. and Ann. Feb. 1830.

753 The heat was measured in Wedgwood's pyrometer by the contraction of pure clay, which is reduced in volume when heated, first by the loss of its water of combination, and afterwards, on the application of more intense heat, by incipient vitrification. The expansion of platina is the test employed by Mr. Daniell in his pyrometer, and this has been found to yield uniform and constant results, such as are in perfect harmony with conclusions drawn from various other independent sources. The instrument for which the author received the Rumford Medal from the Royal Society, in 1833, is described in the Phil. Trans. 1830, part ii., and 1831, part ii.

753 The heat was measured in Wedgwood's pyrometer by the shrinkage of pure clay, which decreases in volume when heated, initially by losing its combined water, and later, with higher temperatures, through early stages of vitrification. Mr. Daniell uses the expansion of platinum as the test in his pyrometer, which has been shown to produce consistent and reliable results that align perfectly with findings from various other independent sources. The instrument for which the author received the Rumford Medal from the Royal Society in 1833 is detailed in the Phil. Trans. 1830, part ii., and 1831, part ii.

754 The above remarks are reprinted verbatim from my third edition, May, 1834. A memoir was afterwards communicated by M. Poisson to the Academy of Sciences, January, 1837, on the solid parts of the globe, containing an epitome of a work entitled "Théorie Mathématique de la Chaleur," published in 1835. In this memoir he controverts the doctrine of the high temperature of a central fluid on similar grounds to those above stated. He imagines, that if the globe ever passed from a liquid to a solid state by radiation of heat, the central nucleus must have begun to cool and consolidate first.

754 The comments above are quoted exactly from my third edition, published in May 1834. Later, M. Poisson presented a paper to the Academy of Sciences in January 1837 about the solid parts of the Earth, summarizing a work called "Théorie Mathématique de la Chaleur," which was published in 1835. In this paper, he disputes the idea of a highly heated central fluid for reasons similar to those mentioned earlier. He suggests that if the Earth ever transitioned from a liquid to a solid state due to heat loss, the central core must have started cooling and solidifying first.

755 Consolations in Travel, p. 271.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Travel Comforts, p. 271.

756 Phil. Trans. 1830, p. 399.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Phil. Trans. 1830, p. 399.

757 Biblioth. Univers. 1833, Electricité.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Univ. Library 1833, Electricity.

758 Phil. Trans. 1832, p. 176; also pp. 172, 173, &c.

758 Phil. Trans. 1832, p. 176; also pp. 172, 173, &c.

759 Hist. Mundi, lib. ii. c. 107.

759 History of the World, book 2, chapter 107.

760 Reduced, by permission, from a figure in plate 40 of Sir H. De la Beche's Geological Sections and Views.

760 Reduced, with permission, from a figure in plate 40 of Sir H. De la Beche's Geological Sections and Views.

761 Phil. Trans. 1828, p. 250.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Phil. Trans. 1828, p. 250.

762 Geology of American Exploring Expedition, p. 369.

762 Geology of American Exploring Expedition, p. 369.

763 Davy, Phil. Trans. 1828, p. 244.

763 Davy, Phil. Trans. 1828, p. 244.

764 Ann. de Chim. et de Phys. tom. iii. p. 181.

764 Ann. de Chim. et de Phys. vol. iii, p. 181.

765 Phil. Trans. 1832, p. 240.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Phil. Trans. 1832, p. 240.

766 Ann. de Chim. et de Phys. tom. xxii.

766 Ann. de Chim. et de Phys. tom. xxii.

767 Quart. Journ. of Sci. 1823, p. 132, note by editor.

767 Quart. Journ. of Sci. 1823, p. 132, note by editor.

768 Phenom. Géol. &c. p. 3.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Phenomenon. Geology, etc. p. 3.

769 Phil. Trans. 1828.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Phil. Trans. 1828.

770 See Daubeny, Encyc. Metrop. part 40.

770 Check out Daubeny, Encyc. Metrop. part 40.

771 Jam. Ed. New Phil. Journ. No. li. p. 31.

771 Jam. Ed. New Phil. Journ. No. 51. p. 31.

772 See Daubeny's Reply to Bischoff, Jam. Ed. New Phil. Journ. No. lii. p. 291; and note in No. liii. p. 158.

772 See Daubeny's response to Bischoff, Jam. Ed. New Phil. Journ. No. 52, p. 291; and see the note in No. 53, p. 158.

773 Poggend. Ann. 1851 translated, Sci. Mem. 1852.

773 Poggend. Ann. 1851 translated, Sci. Mem. 1852.

774 Proceed. Americ. Assoc. 1849.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Go ahead. Americ. Assoc. 1849.

775 Reduced from a sketch given by Sir W. J. Hooker, in his Tour in Iceland, vol. i. p. 149.

775 Based on a sketch provided by Sir W. J. Hooker in his Tour in Iceland, vol. i. p. 149.

776 Journal of a Residence in Iceland, p. 74.

776 Journal of a Residence in Iceland, p. 74.

777 Mackenzie's Iceland.

Mackenzie's Iceland.

778 MS. read to Geol. Soc. of London, Feb. 29, 1832.

778 Manuscript presented to the Geological Society of London, February 29, 1832.

779 From Sir George Mackenzie's Iceland.

From Sir George Mackenzie's Iceland.

780 See Mr. Horner's Anniversary Address, Quart. Journ. Geol. Soc. 1847, liii.

780 See Mr. Horner's Anniversary Address, Quart. Journ. Geol. Soc. 1847, liii.

781 Liebig's Annalen der Chimie und Pharmacie, translated in "Reports and Memoirs" of Cavendish Soc. London, 1848.

781 Liebig's Annals of Chemistry and Pharmacy, translated in "Reports and Memoirs" of the Cavendish Society, London, 1848.

782 On the Cause and Phenomena of Earthquakes, Phil. Trans. vol. li. sec. 58, 1760.

782 On the Cause and Phenomena of Earthquakes, Phil. Trans. vol. li. sec. 58, 1760.

783 Trans. of Assoc. of American Geol. 1840-1842, p. 520.

783 Trans. of Assoc. of American Geol. 1840-1842, p. 520.

784 Mallet, p. 39.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Mallet, p. 39.

785 Scrope on Volcanoes, pp. 58-60.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Scrope on Volcanoes, pp. 58-60.

786 Archiac, Hist, des Progrés de la Géol, 1847, vol. i. pp. 605-610.

786 Archaic, History of Geological Progress, 1847, vol. i. pp. 605-610.

787 Silliman's American Journ. vol. xxii. p. 136. The application of these results to the theory of earthquakes was first suggested to me by Mr. Babbage.

787 Silliman's American Journ. vol. xxii. p. 136. Mr. Babbage was the first to suggest applying these results to the theory of earthquakes.

788 Bulletin de la Soc. Géol. 2d series, vol. iv. p. 1312.

788 Bulletin de la Soc. Géol. 2d series, vol. iv. p. 1312.

789 See p. 468.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ See p. 468.

790 Phil. Zool. tom. i. p. 84.

790 Phil. Zool. vol. 1, p. 84.

791 Phil. Zool. tom. i. p. 62.

791 Phil. Zool. vol. 1, p. 62.

792 Ibid.

Ibid.

793 Phil. Zool. tom. i. p. 227.

793 Phil. Zool. vol. i. p. 227.

794 Ibid. p. 232.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Same source, p. 232.

795 Phil. Zool. tom. i. p. 234.

795 Phil. Zool. vol. i. p. 234.

796 Phil. Zool. p. 64.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Phil. Zool. p. 64.

797 Animaux sans Vert. tom. i. p. 56, Introduction.

797 Animals Without Vert. vol. i. p. 56, Introduction.

798 Lamarck's Phil. Zool. tom. i. p. 356.

798 Lamarck's Phil. Zool. vol. I, p. 356.

799 Ibid. p. 357.

Ibid. p. 357.

800 Genus omne est naturale, in primordio tale creatum, &c. Phil. Bot. § 159. See also ibid. § 162.

800 Every genus is natural, created that way from the beginning, etc. Phil. Bot. § 159. See also ibid. § 162.

801 Cuvier, Dîscours Prélimin. p. 128.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Cuvier, Introductory Discourse. p. 128.

802 Phil. Zool. tom. i. p. 266.

802 Phil. Zool. vol. I, p. 266.

803 Dureau de la Malle, An. des Sci. Nat. tom. xxi. p. 53. Sept. 1830.

803 Dureau de la Malle, Annals of Natural Sciences, vol. 21, p. 53. September 1830.

804 Disc. Prél. p. 139. sixth edition.

804 Disc. Prél. p. 139. sixth edition.

805 Ibid.

Ibid.

806 Güldenstädt, cited by Pritchard, Phys. Hist. of Mankind, vol. i. p. 96.

806 Güldenstädt, mentioned by Pritchard, Phys. Hist. of Mankind, vol. i. p. 96.

807 History of British Quadrupeds, p. 200. 1837.

807 History of British Quadrupeds, p. 200. 1837.

808 Ann. du Muséum d'Hist. Nat. tom. i. p. 234. 1802. The reporters were MM. Cuvier, Lacépède, and Lamarck.

808 Ann. du Muséum d'Hist. Nat. vol. i. p. 234. 1802. The authors were Messrs. Cuvier, Lacépède, and Lamarck.

809 I by no means wish to express an opinion that seeds cannot retain their vitality after an entombment of 3,000 years; but one of my botanical friends who entertained a philosophical doubt on this subject, being desirous of ascertaining the truth of three or four alleged instances of the germination of "mummy wheat," discovered, on communicating with several Egyptian travellers, that they had procured the grains in question, not directly from the catacombs, but from the Arabs, who are always ready to supply strangers with an article now very frequently in demand. The presence of an occasional grain of Indian corn or maize in several of the parcels of grain shown to my friend as coming from the catacombs confirmed his scepticism.

809 I definitely don't mean to suggest that seeds can't stay viable after being buried for 3,000 years; however, one of my botany friends, who had some doubts about this, wanted to confirm a few claims about the germination of "mummy wheat." He found out by talking to several Egyptian travelers that they had actually gotten the grains in question, not directly from the catacombs, but from Arabs who are always eager to sell visitors items that are currently in high demand. The occasional grain of Indian corn or maize found in some of the grain samples shown to my friend as being from the catacombs further supported his skepticism.

810 Phil. Zool., tom. i. p. 227.

810 Phil. Zool., vol. i. p. 227.

811 L'Origine et la Patrie des Céréales, &c., Annales des Sciences Natur., tom. ix. p. 61.

811 The Origin and Homeland of Cereals, etc., Annals of Natural Sciences, vol. ix, p. 61.

812 Smith's Introduction to Botany, p. 138, edit. 1807.

812 Smith's Introduction to Botany, p. 138, ed. 1807.

813 See Mr. Knight's Observations, Hort Trans., vol. ii. p. 160.

813 See Mr. Knight's Observations, Hort Trans., vol. 2, p. 160.

814 Hort. Trans. vol. iv. p. 19.

814 Hort. Trans. vol. iv. p. 19.

815 Loudon's Mag. of Nat. Hist., Sept. 1830, vol. iii. p. 408.

815 Loudon's Magazine of Natural History, September 1830, volume three, page 408.

816 Hort. Trans. vol. iii. p. 173.

816 Hort. Trans. vol. iii. p. 173.

817 M. Roulin, Ann. des Sci. Nat. tom. xvi. p. 16. 1829.

817 M. Roulin, Ann. des Sci. Nat. vol. 16, p. 16. 1829.

818 Mem. du Mus. d'Hist. Nat.—Jameson, Ed. New Phil. Journ. Nos. 6, 7, 8.

818 Mem. du Mus. d'Hist. Nat.—Jameson, Ed. New Phil. Journ. Nos. 6, 7, 8.

819 In the New Forest, near Ringwood, Hants, by Mr. Toomer, keeper of Broomy Lodge. I have conversed with witnesses of the fact.

819 In the New Forest, near Ringwood, Hampshire, by Mr. Toomer, the keeper of Broomy Lodge. I've spoken with people who saw it happen.

820 Mém. du Mus. d'Hist. Nat.

820 Memoirs of the Museum of Natural History

821 Dureau de la Malle. Ann. des Sci. Nat., tom. xxi. p. 58.

821 Dureau de la Malle. Ann. des Sci. Nat., vol. 21, p. 58.

822 Darwin's Journ. in Voyage of H.M.S. Beagle, p. 475.

822 Darwin's Journal in the Voyage of H.M.S. Beagle, p. 475.

823 Fauna Boreali-Americana, p. 273.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Fauna of North America, p. 273.

824 Mr. Corse on the Habits, &c. of the Elephant, Phil. Trans., 1799.

824 Mr. Corse on the Habits, etc. of the Elephant, Phil. Trans., 1799.

825 Linn. Trans. vol. xiii. p. 244.

825 Linn. Trans. vol. xiii. p. 244.

826 Pers. Narr. of Travels to the Equinoctial Regions of the New Continent in the years 1779-1804.

826 Personal Narrative of Travels to the Equatorial Regions of the New Continent from 1779 to 1804.

827 Phil. Trans. 1787. Additional Remarks, Phil. Trans. 1789. See also Essays by the late Dr. Samuel G. Morton, on Prolific Hybrids, &c.; and on Hybridity as a Test of Species.—American Journ. of Science, vol. iii. 1847.

827 Phil. Trans. 1787. Additional Remarks, Phil. Trans. 1789. See also Essays by the late Dr. Samuel G. Morton on Prolific Hybrids, etc.; and on Hybridity as a Test of Species.—American Journ. of Science, vol. iii. 1847.

828 Prichard, vol. i. p. 217.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Prichard, vol. 1, p. 217.

829 Ibid. p. 97.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Same source, p. 97.

830 See Barton on the Geography of Plants, p. 67.

830 See Barton on the Geography of Plants, p. 67.

831 Georg. lib. iii. 273.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Geog. Book 3, 273.

832 Hon. and Rev. W. Herbert, Hort. Trans., vol. iv. p. 41.

832 Hon. and Rev. W. Herbert, Horticultural Transactions, vol. iv. p. 41.

833 Ibid.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Same source.

834 Essai Elémentaire, &c., 3me partie.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Basic Essay, etc., part 3.

835 Intr. to Entom. vol. ii. p. 504. ed. 1817

835 Introduction to Entomology vol. ii. p. 504. ed. 1817

836 Prichard's Phys. Hist. of Mankind, vol. i. p. 159.

836 Prichard's Phys. Hist. of Mankind, vol. i. p. 159.

837 Ch. White on the Regular Gradation in Man, &c. 1799.

837 Ch. White on the Regular Gradation in Man, &c. 1799.

838 R. G. Latham, The Nat. Hist. of the Varieties of Man, 8vo. London, 1850.

838 R. G. Latham, The Natural History of the Varieties of Man, 8vo. London, 1850.

839 Lawrence, Lectures on Phys. Zool. and Nat. Hist. of Man, p. 190. Ed. 1823.

839 Lawrence, Lectures on Phys. Zool. and Nat. Hist. of Man, p. 190. Ed. 1823.

840 E. R. A. Serres, Anatomie comparée du Cerveau, illustrated by numerous plates, tome i. 1824.

840 E. R. A. Serres, Comparative Anatomy of the Brain, illustrated with numerous plates, volume 1. 1824.

841 Barton's Lectures on the Geography of Plants, p. 2. 1827.

841 Barton's Lectures on the Geography of Plants, p. 2. 1827.

842 Pers. Nar., vol. v. p. 180.

842 Personal Narrative, vol. 5, p. 180.

843 Ibid.

Ibid.

844 Essai Elémentaire de Géographie Botanique. Extrait du 18me vol. du Dict. des Sci. Nat.

844 Basic Essay on Botanical Geography. Excerpt from the 18th volume of the Dictionary of Natural Sciences.

845 Prichard, vol. i. p. 36. Brown, Appendix to Flinders.

845 Prichard, vol. i. p. 36. Brown, Appendix to Flinders.

846 Foster, Observations, &c.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Foster, Observations, etc.

847 Humboldt, Pers. Nar., vol. i. p. 270 of the translation. Prichard, Phys. Hist. of Mankind, vol. i. p. 37.

847 Humboldt, Personal Narrative, vol. 1, p. 270 of the translated version. Prichard, Physical History of Mankind, vol. 1, p. 37.

848 Voyage of the Beagle, 2d edition, 1845, p. 377.

848 Voyage of the Beagle, 2nd edition, 1845, p. 377.

849 See a farther subdivision, by which twenty-seven provinces are made, by M. Alph. De Candolle, son of De Candolle. Monogr. des Campanulées. Paris, 1830.

849 See a further breakdown, which creates twenty-seven provinces, by M. Alph. De Candolle, son of De Candolle. Monogr. des Campanulées. Paris, 1830.

850 De Candolle, Essai Elémen. de Géog. Botan., p. 45.

850 De Candolle, Intro to Plant Geography, p. 45.

851 I am indebted for the above sketch of distinct regions of algæ to my friend Dr. Joseph Hooker, who refers the botanical student to the labors of Dr. Harvey, of Trinity College, Dublin.

851 I owe the above outline of different regions of algae to my friend Dr. Joseph Hooker, who directs the botany student to the work of Dr. Harvey from Trinity College, Dublin.

852 Annuaire du Bureau des Longitudes.

852 Directory of the Bureau of Longitudes.

853 Linn., Tour in Lapland, vol. ii. p. 282.

853 Linn., Tour in Lapland, vol. ii. p. 282.

854 Fries, cited by Lindley, Introd. to Nat. Syst. of Botany.

854 Fries, mentioned by Lindley, Introduction to Natural Systems of Botany.

855 System of Physiological Botany, vol. ii. p. 405.

855 System of Physiological Botany, vol. ii. p. 405.

856 Brown, Append. to Tuckey, No. v. p. 481.

856 Brown, Appendix to Tuckey, No. v. p. 481.

857 Phil. Trans. 1696.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Phil. Trans. 1696.

858 System of Physiological Botany, vol. ii. p. 403.

858 System of Physiological Botany, vol. ii. p. 403.

859 Greville, Introduction to Algæ Britannicæ, p. 12.

859 Greville, Introduction to British Algae, p. 12.

860 Linnæus, Amœn. Acad., vol. ii. p. 409.

860 Linnaeus, Amœn. Acad., vol. ii. p. 409.

861 Amœn. Acad., vol. iv. Essay 75. § 8.

861 Amœn. Acad., vol. iv. Essay 75. § 8.

862 Ibid., vol. vi. § 22.

862 Same source, vol. vi. § 22.

863 Smith's Introd. to Phys. and Syst. Botany, p. 304. 1807.

863 Smith's Introduction to Physics and Systematic Botany, p. 304. 1807.

864 This information was communicated to me by Professor Henslow, of Cambridge.

864 Professor Henslow from Cambridge shared this information with me.

865 Book iii. ch. iv.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Book 3, Chapter 4.

866 De Candolle, Essai Elémen. &c., p. 50.

866 De Candolle, Essay Elements. &c., p. 50.

867 Quarterly Review, vol. xxx. p. 8.

867 Quarterly Review, vol. 30. p. 8.

868 Essay on the Habitable Earth, Amœn. Acad., vol. ii. p. 409.

868 Essay on the Habitable Earth, Amœn. Acad., vol. ii. p. 409.

869 Principles of Botany, p. 389.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Botany Basics, p. 389.

870 Ibid.

Ibid.

871 Buffon, vol. v.—On the Virginian Opossum.

871 Buffon, vol. v.—About the Virginian Opossum.

872 Prichard's Phys. Hist. of Mankind, vol. i. p. 54.

872 Prichard's Physical History of Mankind, volume 1, page 54.

873 In the above enumeration of the leading zoological provinces of land quadrupeds I have been most kindly assisted by Mr. Waterhouse of the British Museum, author of a most able and comprehensive work on the "Natural History of the Mammalia," now in the course of publication. London, Bailliere, 1846.

873 In the list above of the main regions where land mammals are found, I received generous help from Mr. Waterhouse of the British Museum, who is the author of a highly skilled and thorough work on the "Natural History of Mammals," currently being published. London, Bailliere, 1846.

874 Pennant's Hist. of Quadrupeds, cited by Prichard, Phys. Hist. of Mankind, vol. i. p. 66.

874 Pennant's History of Quadrupeds, mentioned by Prichard, Physical History of Mankind, vol. i. p. 66.

875 Natural History of the Mammalia, vol. i., on the Marsupials. London, Bailliere, 1846.

875 Natural History of the Mammals, vol. i., on the Marsupials. London, Bailliere, 1846.

876 Description of the Equatorial Regions.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Overview of the Equatorial Regions.

877 Prichard, Phys. Hist., of Mankind, vol. i. p. 75.

877 Prichard, Phys. Hist., of Mankind, vol. i. p. 75.

878 Buffon, vol. v. p. 204.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Buffon, vol. 5, p. 204.

879 Sir T. D. Lauder, Bart., on the Floods in Morayshire, Aug. 1829, p. 302, second edition.

879 Sir T. D. Lauder, Bart., on the Floods in Morayshire, Aug. 1829, p. 302, second edition.

880 Expedition from Pittsburg to the Rocky Mountains, vol. ii. p. 153.

880 Expedition from Pittsburgh to the Rocky Mountains, vol. ii. p. 153.

881 Richardson's Fauna Boreali-Americana, p. 16.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Richardson's North American Fauna, p. 16.

882 Phil. Trans., vol. ii. p. 872.

882 Phil. Trans., vol. ii. p. 872.

883 Wood's Zoography, vol. i. p. 11.

883 Wood's Zoography, vol. i. p. 11.

884 On the authority of Mr. Campbell. Library of Entert. Know., Menageries. vol. i. p. 152.

884 According to Mr. Campbell. Library of Entert. Know., Menageries. vol. i. p. 152.

885 Cuvier's Animal Kingdom by Griffiths, vol. ii. p. 109. Library of Entertaining Knowledge, Menageries, vol. i. p. 366.

885 Cuvier's Animal Kingdom by Griffiths, vol. ii. p. 109. Library of Entertaining Knowledge, Menageries, vol. i. p. 366.

886 Horsfield, Zoological Researches in Java, No. ii., from which the figure is taken.

886 Horsfield, Zoological Researches in Java, No. ii., which is where the figure is taken from.

887 Append. to Parry's Second Voyage, years 1819-20.

887 Append. to Parry's Second Voyage, years 1819-20.

888 Account of the Arctic Regions, vol. i. p. 518.

888 Account of the Arctic Regions, vol. i. p. 518.

889 Turton in a note to Goldsmith's Nat. Hist., vol. iii. p. 43.

889 Turton in a note to Goldsmith's Nat. Hist., vol. iii. p. 43.

890 Supplement to Parry's First Voyage of Discovery, p. 189.

890 Supplement to Parry's First Voyage of Discovery, p. 189.

891 Goldman's American Nat. Hist., vol. i. p. 22.

891 Goldman's American Nat. Hist., vol. i. p. 22.

892 Dr. Richardson, Brit. Assoc. Report, vol. v. p. 161.

892 Dr. Richardson, British Association Report, vol. 5, p. 161.

893 System of Geography, vol. v. p. 157.

893 System of Geography, vol. 5, p. 157.

894 Spix and Martius, Reise, &c., vol. iii. pp. 1011. 1013.

894 Spix and Martius, Journey, &c., vol. iii. pp. 1011. 1013.

895 Sir W. Parish's Buenos Ayres, p. 187., and Robertson's Letters on Paraguay, p. 220.

895 Sir W. Parish's Buenos Aires, p. 187., and Robertson's Letters on Paraguay, p. 220.

896 United Service Journal, No. xxiv. p. 697.

896 United Service Journal, No. 24, p. 697.

897 Krantz, vol. i. p. 129., cited by Goldsmith, Nat. Hist., vol. iii. p. 260.

897 Krantz, vol. i. p. 129., cited by Goldsmith, Nat. Hist., vol. iii. p. 260.

898 Darwin's Journal, &c., p. 461.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Darwin's Journal, etc., p. 461.

899 Prichard, vol. i. p. 47.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Prichard, vol. 1, p. 47.

900 Bewick's Birds, vol. ii. p. 294., who cites Latham.

900 Bewick's Birds, vol. ii. p. 294, which references Latham.

901 Pisa, 1827 (not sold).

Pisa, 1827 (not sold).

902 Bachman, Silliman's Amer. Journ., No. 61, p. 92.

902 Bachman, Silliman's American Journal, No. 61, p. 92.

903 Voyage aux Régions Equinoxiales, tome vii. p. 429.

903 Journey to the Equatorial Regions, volume vii. p. 429.

904 Fleming, Phil. Zool., vol. ii. p. 43.

904 Fleming, Phil. Zool., vol. 2, p. 43.

905 Silliman's Amer. Journ., No. 61. p. 83.

905 Silliman's Amer. Journ., No. 61. p. 83.

906 Richardson, Brit. Assoc. Rep., vol. v. p. 202.

906 Richardson, British Association Report, vol. 5, p. 202.

907 Brit. Animals, p. 149., who cites Sibbald.

907 British Animals, p. 149., who references Sibbald.

908 Zool. Journ. vol iii. p. 406. Dec. 1827.

908 Zool. Journ. vol iii. p. 406. Dec. 1827.

909 Sur les Habitations des Animaux Marins.—Ann. du Mus., tome. xv., cited by Prichard, Phys. Hist. of Mankind, vol. i. p. 51.

909 On the Habitats of Marine Animals.—Ann. du Mus., vol. xv., referenced by Prichard, Phys. Hist. of Mankind, vol. i. p. 51.

910 Brit. Assoc. Reports, vol. v. p. 203.

910 Brit. Assoc. Reports, vol. v. p. 203.

911 Report to the Brit. Assoc., 1845, p. 192.

911 Report to the British Association, 1845, p. 192.

912 Richardson, ibid. p. 190.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Richardson, same source, p. 190.

913 Sir J. Richardson, ibid. p. 190.

913 Sir J. Richardson, same source, p. 190.

914 Phil. Trans. 1747, p. 395.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Phil. Trans. 1747, p. 395.

915 Amœn. Acad., Essay 75.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Amœn. Acad., Essay 75.

916 Report to the Brit Assoc. 1843, p. 130.

916 Report to the Brit Assoc. 1843, p. 130.

917 Quart. Journ., Geol. Soc., 1846, vol. ii. p. 268.

917 Quart. Journ., Geol. Soc., 1846, vol. ii. p. 268.

918 Four individuals of a large species of land shell (Bulimus), from Valparaiso, were brought to England by Lieutenant Graves, who accompanied Captain King in his expedition to the Straits of Magellan. They had been packed up in a box, and enveloped in cotton: two for a space of thirteen, one for seventeen, and a fourth for upwards of twenty months: but, on being exposed by Mr. Broderip to the warmth of a fire in London, and provided with tepid water and leaves, they revived, and lived for several months in Mr. Loddiges' palm-house, till accidentally drowned.

918 Four individuals of a large species of land snail (Bulimus), from Valparaiso, were brought to England by Lieutenant Graves, who was part of Captain King’s expedition to the Straits of Magellan. They had been packed in a box and wrapped in cotton: two were in there for thirteen months, one for seventeen, and a fourth for over twenty months. However, when Mr. Broderip exposed them to the warmth of a fire in London and provided them with warm water and leaves, they revived and lived for several months in Mr. Loddiges' palm house until they accidentally drowned.

919 Camb. Phil. Trans., vol. iv. 1831.

919 Camb. Phil. Trans., vol. iv. 1831.

920 Edin. New Phil. Journ., April 1844

920 Edin. New Phil. Journ., April 1844

921 Phil. Trans. 1835, p. 303.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Phil. Trans. 1835, p. 303.

922 The specimen is preserved in the Museum of the Zool. Soc. of London.

922 The specimen is kept in the Museum of the Zoological Society of London.

923 This specimen is in the collection of my friend Mr. Broderip, who observes, that this crab, which was apparently in perfect health, could not have cast her shell for six years, whereas some naturalists have stated that the species moults annually, without limiting the moulting period to the early stages of the growth of the animal.

923 This specimen is in the collection of my friend Mr. Broderip, who notes that this crab, which seemed to be in perfect health, has not shed its shell in six years. In contrast, some naturalists have claimed that this species molts every year, without restricting the molting process to the early stages of the animal's growth.

924 Quart. Journ. Geol. Soc., vol. iv. p. 336.

924 Quart. Journ. Geol. Soc., vol. iv. p. 336.

925 Voy. aux Terres Australes, tom. i. p. 492.

925 Voy. to the Southern Lands, vol. i. p. 492.

926 Géographie Générale des Insectes et des Arachnides. Mém. du Mus. d'Hist. Nat., tom. iii.

926 General Geography of Insects and Arachnids. Memoirs of the Museum of Natural History, vol. iii.

927 Kirby and Spence, vol. iv. p. 487; and other authors.

927 Kirby and Spence, vol. 4, p. 487; and other authors.

928 Kirby and Spence, vol. iv. p. 497.

928 Kirby and Spence, vol. 4, p. 497.

929 Washington Irving's Tour in the Prairies, ch. ix.

929 Washington Irving's Tour in the Prairies, ch. ix.

930 Malte-Brun, vol. v. p. 379.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Malte-Brun, vol. 5, p. 379.

931 Kirby and Spence, vol. ii. p. 9. 1817.

931 Kirby and Spence, vol. ii. p. 9. 1817.

932 Kirby and Spence, vol. ii. p. 12. 1817.

932 Kirby and Spence, vol. ii. p. 12. 1817.

933 I am indebted to Lieutenant Graves, R.N., for this information.

933 I want to thank Lieutenant Graves, R.N., for this information.

934 I state this fact on the authority of my friend, Mr. John Curtis.

934 I'm sharing this fact based on the word of my friend, Mr. John Curtis.

935 Brand's Select Dissert. from the Amœn. Acad., vol. i. p. 118.

935 Brand's Selected Dissertation from the Amen. Academy, vol. i. p. 118.

936 Ibid.

Ibid.

937 Sir H. Davy, Consolations in Travel, p. 74.

937 Sir H. Davy, Consolations in Travel, p. 74.

938 W. von Humboldt, "On the Kawi Language," &c. cited in Cosmos. Introduction.

938 W. von Humboldt, "On the Kawi Language," etc. cited in Cosmos. Introduction.

939 Egypten's Stelle, &c. Egypt restored to her Place in Universal History, by C. C. J. Bunsen. 1845.

939 Egypt's position, etc. Egypt reclaimed its place in world history, by C. C. J. Bunsen. 1845.

940 For Grecian and Asiatic deluges, see above, p. 356.; Cimbrian, p. 331., Chinese, p. 7. Peruvian, p. 502.; Chilian or Araucanian deluge, p. 500.

940 For the floods in Greece and Asia, see above, p. 356.; Cimbrian, p. 331.; Chinese, p. 7.; Peruvian, p. 502.; Chilian or Araucanian flood, p. 500.

941 See p. 615.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ See p. 615.

942 Malte-Brun's Geography, vol. iii. p. 419.

942 Malte-Brun's Geography, vol. iii. p. 419.

943 Chamisso states that the water which they brought up was cooler, and in their opinion, less salt. It is difficult to conceive its being fresher near the bottom, except where submarine springs may happen to rise.

943 Chamisso mentions that the water they brought up was cooler and, according to them, less salty. It’s hard to imagine that the water is fresher near the bottom, except in places where underwater springs might come up.

944 Kotzebue's Voyage, 1815-1818. Quarterly Review, vol. xxvi. p. 361.

944 Kotzebue's Voyage, 1815-1818. Quarterly Review, vol. xxvi. p. 361.

945 Narrative of a Voyage to the Pacific, &c., in the years 1825, 1826, 1827, 1828, p. 170.

945 Account of a Journey to the Pacific, etc., in the years 1825, 1826, 1827, 1828, p. 170.

946 Gloger, Abänd. der Vögel, p. 103.; Pallas, Zoog. Rosso-Asiat., tom. ii. p. 197.

946 Gloger, Changes in Birds, p. 103.; Pallas, Zoology of Russia and Asia, vol. ii, p. 197.

947 Syst. of Geog., vol. viii. p. 169.

947 Syst. of Geog., vol. viii. p. 169.

948 De terrâ habitabili incremento; also Prichard, Phys. Hist, of Mankind, vol. i. p. 17., where the hypotheses of different naturalists are enumerated.

948 On the increase of habitable land; also Prichard, Phys. Hist, of Mankind, vol. i. p. 17., where the theories of various naturalists are listed.

949 Necker, Phytozool. Philosoph. p. 21.; Brocchi, Conch. Foss. Subap., tome i. p. 229.

949 Necker, Phytozool. Philosoph. p. 21.; Brocchi, Conch. Foss. Subap., vol. i. p. 229.

950 Amœn. Acad. vol. vi. p. 17. § 12.

950 Amœn. Acad. vol. vi. p. 17. § 12.

951 Ibid. vol. vii. p. 409.

951 Same source, vol. 7, p. 409.

952 Amœn. Acad., vol. vi. p. 17. § 11, 12.

952 Amœn. Acad., vol. vi. p. 17. § 11, 12.

953 Kirby and Spence, vol. i. p. 178.

953 Kirby and Spence, vol. 1, p. 178.

954 Amœn. Acad., vol. vi. p. 26. § 14.

954 Amœn. Acad., vol. vi. p. 26. § 14.

955 Kirby and Spence, vol. iv. p. 218.

955 Kirby and Spence, vol. iv. p. 218.

956 Kirby and Spence, vol. i. p. 250.

956 Kirby and Spence, vol. i. p. 250.

957 Wilcke, Amœn. Acad. c. ii.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Wilcke, Amœn. Acad. ch. ii.

958 Kirby and Spence, vol. i. p. 174.

958 Kirby and Spence, vol. i. p. 174.

959 Trans. Linn. Soc., vol. vi.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Trans. Linn. Soc., vol. 6.

960 Lib. Ent. Know., Insect Trans., p. 203. See Haworth, Lep.

960 Lib. Ent. Know., Insect Trans., p. 203. See Haworth, Lep.

961 Reaumur, ii. 337.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Reaumur, vol. 2, p. 337.

962 Lib. Ent. Know., Insect Trans., p. 212.

962 Lib. Ent. Know., Insect Trans., p. 212.

963 Kirby and Spence, vol. i. p. 183. Castle, Phil. Trans., xxx. 346.

963 Kirby and Spence, vol. 1, p. 183. Castle, Phil. Trans., 30, 346.

964 Travels in Africa, p. 257. Kirby and Spence, vol. i. p. 215.

964 Travels in Africa, p. 257. Kirby and Spence, vol. i. p. 215.

965 Journal of a Residence in Iceland, p. 276.

965 Journal of a Residence in Iceland, p. 276.

966 Tour in Iceland, vol. i. p. 64, 2nd edit.

966 Tour in Iceland, vol. i. p. 64, 2nd edit.

967 Travels in Brazil, vol. i. p. 260.

967 Travels in Brazil, vol. i. p. 260.

968 Ed. Phil. Journ., No. xxii p. 287. Oct. 1824.

968 Ed. Phil. Journ., No. xxii p. 287. Oct. 1824.

969 Ray. Syn. Quad., p. 214.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Ray. Syn. Quad., p. 214.

970 Fleming, Ed. Phil. Journ., No. xxii. p. 295.

970 Fleming, Ed. Phil. Journ., No. xxii. p. 295.

971 Fleming, ibid., p. 292.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Fleming, same source, p. 292.

972 Vol. iii. London, 1821.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Vol. 3. London, 1821.

973 Land Birds, vol. i. p. 316. ed. 1821.

973 Land Birds, vol. i. p. 316. ed. 1821.

974 Some have complained that inscriptions on tomb-stones convey no general information, except that individuals were born and died, accidents which must happen alike to all men. But the death of a species is so remarkable an event in natural history that it deserves commemoration, and it is with no small interest that we learn, from the archives of the University of Oxford, the exact day and year when the remains of the last specimen of the dodo, which had been permitted to rot in the Ashmolean Museum, were cast away. The relics, we are told, were "a musæo subducta, annuente vice-cancellario aliisque curatoribus, ad ea lustranda convocatis, die Januarii 8vo, A.D. 1755." Zool. Journ. No. 12. p. 559. 1828.

974 Some people have pointed out that inscriptions on tombstones provide no relevant information, other than that people were born and died—experiences that every person goes through. However, the extinction of a species is such a significant event in natural history that it deserves to be remembered. It's fascinating to find out, from the archives of the University of Oxford, the exact date when the remains of the last dodo, which had been left to decay in the Ashmolean Museum, were finally disposed of. We are informed that the remains were "a musæo subducta, annuente vice-cancellario aliisque curatoribus, ad ea lustranda convocatis, die Januarii 8vo, CE 1755." Zool. Journ. No. 12. p. 559. 1828.

975 Penny Cyclopædia, "Dodo." 1837.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Penny Cyclopedia, "Dodo." 1837.

976 Messrs. Strickland and Melville on "the Dodo and its Kindred." London, 1848.

976 Messrs. Strickland and Melville on "the Dodo and its Kindred." London, 1848.

977 Pers. Nar. vol. iv.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Personal Narrative vol. 4.

978 Quarterly Review, vol. xxi. p. 335.

978 Quarterly Review, vol. xxi. p. 335.

979 Ibid.

Ibid.

980 Ulloa's Voyage. Wood's Zoog. vol. i. p. 9.

980 Ulloa's Journey. Wood's Zoo. vol. i. p. 9.

981 Buffon, vol. v. p. 100. Ulloa's Voyage, vol. ii. p. 220.

981 Buffon, vol. 5, p. 100. Ulloa's Voyage, vol. 2, p. 220.

982 Travels in Iceland in 1810, p. 342.

982 Travels in Iceland in 1810, p. 342.

983 Maclaren, art. America, Encyc. Brit.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Maclaren, "America," Britannica.

984 See a note on this subject, chap. x. p. 157.

984 See a note on this topic, chap. x. p. 157.

985 See above, p. 317.

See above, p. 317.

986 Darwin's Journal, p. 156., 2d ed. p. 133. Sir W. Parish, Buenos Ayres, &c. p. 371. and 151.

986 Darwin's Journal, p. 156, 2nd ed. p. 133. Sir W. Parish, Buenos Aires, etc. p. 371 and 151.

987 See above, chap. vii. p. 112.

987 See above, chap. vii. p. 112.

988 See above, chaps. vi. vii. and viii.

988 See above, chaps. vi. vii. and viii.

989 Journ. of Nat. Hist. &c. 2d edit., 1845, p. 175; also Lyell's 2d Visit to the United States, vol. i. p. 351.

989 Journal of Natural History, 2nd edition, 1845, p. 175; also Lyell's 2nd Visit to the United States, vol. 1, p. 351.

990 This and the preceding chapter, on the causes of extinction of species and their present geographical distribution, are reprinted almost verbatim from the original edition of the second volume of "The Principles," published in January, 1832. It was I believe the first attempt to point out how former changes in the geography and local climate of many parts of the globe must be taken into account when we endeavor to explain the actual provinces of plants and animals, the changes alluded to having been proved by geological evidence to be subsequent to the creation of a great proportion of the species now living, and these having been, according to the view which I advocated, introduced in succession, and not all at one geological epoch. In my third volume, published in May, 1833, I announced my conviction that the greater part of the existing Fauna and Flora of Sicily were older than the mountains, plains, and rivers, which the same species of animals and plants now inhabit. (Prin. of Geol., vol. iii. ch. ix.; repeated in Elements of Geol., 2d edit., vol. i. p. 297.) This line of reasoning has since been ably followed up and elucidated by Professor E. Forbes in an excellent paper (published in 1846) already alluded to. (See page 86.)

990 This chapter, along with the previous one about the reasons for species extinction and their current geographical distribution, is nearly a word-for-word reproduction from the original second volume of "The Principles," published in January 1832. I believe this was the first effort to highlight how past changes in geography and local climate across various regions must be considered when we try to understand the current distribution of plants and animals. These changes have been proven by geological evidence to have occurred after the majority of species we see today were created, and, according to my perspective, these species were introduced in stages rather than all at once during a single geological period. In my third volume, released in May 1833, I expressed my belief that most of the existing fauna and flora of Sicily predate the mountains, plains, and rivers that the same species now occupy. (Prin. of Geol., vol. iii. ch. ix.; repeated in Elements of Geol., 2d edit., vol. i. p. 297.) This line of reasoning has since been effectively developed and clarified by Professor E. Forbes in an excellent paper (published in 1846) that has already been mentioned. (See page 86.)

991 Essai Elémentaire, &c. p. 46.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Basic Essay, etc. p. 46.

992 Geog. des Plantes. Diet. des Sci.

992 Geography of Plants. Dictionary of Sciences.

993 See Catalogue of Brit. Insects, by John Curtis, Esq.

993 See Catalogue of British Insects, by John Curtis, Esq.

994 See some good remarks on the Formation of Soils, Bakewell's Geology, chap. xviii.

994 Check out some insightful comments on Soil Formation in Bakewell's Geology, chapter xviii.

995 See Professor Sedgwick's Anniversary Address to the Geological Society, Feb. 1831, p. 24.

995 Check out Professor Sedgwick's Anniversary Address to the Geological Society, Feb. 1831, p. 24.

996 Treatise on Rivers and Torrents, p. 5. Garston's translation.

996 Treatise on Rivers and Torrents, p. 5. Garston's translation.

997 De la Beche, Geol. Man., p. 184., 1st ed.

997 De la Beche, Geol. Man., p. 184., 1st ed.

998 Phil. Trans., vol. ii. p. 294.

998 Phil. Trans., vol. ii. p. 294.

999 Maclaren, art. America, Encyc. Britannica.

999 Maclaren, article on America, Encyclopaedia Britannica.

1000 Maclaren, art. America, Encyc. Britannica, where the position of the American forests, in accordance with this theory, is laid down in a map.

1000 Maclaren, article on America, Encyclopedia Britannica, where the location of the American forests, according to this theory, is shown on a map.

1001 Annuaire du Bureau des Long. 1834.

1001 Yearbook of the Office of Long. 1834.

1002 Since this was written I have seen in New Brunswick (1852) a lake formed by beavers who had thrown a dam, consisting of stakes, stones, and mud, across the course of a small streamlet, between Dorchester and the Portage south of the Peticodiac river. The beavers have since been extirpated by man, but the lake remains, and musk rats have taken possession of the shallow parts of the lake to build their habitations in them.

1002 Since this was written, I have seen a lake created by beavers in New Brunswick (1852). They built a dam made of sticks, stones, and mud across the path of a small stream between Dorchester and the Portage south of the Peticodiac River. Although humans have since wiped out the beavers, the lake is still there, and muskrats have moved into the shallow areas to build their homes.

1003 For a catalogue of plants which form peat, see Rev. Dr. Rennie's Essays on Peat, p. 171; and Dr. MacCulloch's Western Isles, vol. i. p. 129.

1003 For a list of plants that produce peat, check out Rev. Dr. Rennie's Essays on Peat, p. 171; and Dr. MacCulloch's Western Isles, vol. i. p. 129.

1004 Irish Bog Reports, p. 209.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Irish Bog Reports, p. 209.

1005 System of Geology, vol. ii. p. 353.

1005 System of Geology, vol. ii. p. 353.

1006 Rev. Dr. Rennie on Peat, p. 260.

1006 Rev. Dr. Rennie on Peat, p. 260.

1007 Darwin's Journal, p. 349.; 2d ed. p. 287.

1007 Darwin's Journal, p. 349.; 2nd ed. p. 287.

1008 Rennie's Essays on Peat, p. 65.

1008 Rennie's Essays on Peat, p. 65.

1009 Ibid. p. 30.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Same source, p. 30.

1010 Essays on Peat, &c., p. 74.

1010 Essays on Peat, etc., p. 74.

1011 See above, p. 388, note.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ See above, p. 388, note.

1012 Ehrenberg, Taylor's Scientific Mem. vol. i. part iii. p. 402.

1012 Ehrenberg, Taylor's Scientific Memoir, vol. 1, part 3, p. 402.

1013 Dr. Rennie, on Peat, p. 521; where several other instances are referred to.

1013 Dr. Rennie, on Peat, p. 521; where several other examples are mentioned.

1014 Phil. Trans., vol. xxxviii. 1734.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Phil. Trans., vol. 38. 1734.

1015 Dr. Rennie, on Peat, &c., p. 521.

1015 Dr. Rennie, on Peat, &c., p. 521.

1016 Syst. of Geol. vol. ii. pp. 340-346.

1016 System of Geology vol. ii. pp. 340-346.

1017 Ibid. p. 531.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Same source, p. 531.

1018 Phil. Trans. vol. xv. p. 949.

1018 Phil. Trans. vol. 15. p. 949.

1019 Gilpin, Observ. on Picturesque Beauty, &c., 1772.

1019 Gilpin, Observations on Picturesque Beauty, etc., 1772.

1020 Travels, &c., in 1841, 1842, vol. i. p. 143.

1020 Travels, etc., in 1841, 1842, vol. i. p. 143.

1021 Bulletin de la Soc. Géol. de France, tom. ii. p. 26.

1021 Bulletin of the Geological Society of France, vol. ii, p. 26.

1022 Dr. Rennie, Essays on Peat Moss, p. 205.

1022 Dr. Rennie, Essays on Peat Moss, p. 205.

1023 M. G. A. De Luc, Mercure de France, Sept. 1809.

1023 M. G. A. De Luc, Mercure de France, September 1809.

1024 See p. 262.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ See p. 262.

1025 Stratton, Ed. Phil. Journ., No. v. p. 62.

1025 Stratton, Ed. Phil. Journ., No. v. p. 62.

1026 Travels in North Africa in the Years 1818, 1819, and 1820, p. 83.

1026 Travels in North Africa in the Years 1818, 1819, and 1820, p. 83.

1027 Mém. de l'Acad. des Sci. de Paris, 1772. See also the case of the buried church of Eccles, above, p. 306.

1027 Memoirs of the Academy of Sciences of Paris, 1772. See also the case of the buried church of Eccles, above, p. 306.

1028 Phil. Trans., vol. ii. p. 722.

1028 Phil. Trans., vol. ii. p. 722.

1029 Boase on Submersion of Part of the Mount's Bay, &c., Trans. Roy. Geol. Soc. of Cornwall, vol. ii. p. 140.

1029 Boase on the Submersion of Part of Mount's Bay, etc., Transactions of the Royal Geological Society of Cornwall, vol. ii, p. 140.

1030 Narrative of Journey from Agra to Oujein, Asiatic Researches, vol. vi. p. 36.

1030 Narrative of Journey from Agra to Ujjain, Asiatic Researches, vol. vi. p. 36.

1031 Asiatic Journal, vol. ix. p. 35.

1031 Asiatic Journal, vol. 9, p. 35.

1032 See above, p. 460.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ See above, p. 460.

1033 Sir J. Malcolm's Central India. Appendix, No. 2. p. 324.

1033 Sir J. Malcolm's Central India. Appendix, No. 2. p. 324.

1034 Sir T. D. Lauder, Bart., on Floods in Morayshire, Aug. 1839, p. 177.

1034 Sir T. D. Lauder, Bart., on Floods in Morayshire, Aug. 1839, p. 177.

1035 Dodsley's Ann. Regist., 1788.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Dodsley's Ann. Regist., 1788.

1036 Edwards, Hist. of West Indies, vol. i. p. 235, ed. 1801.

1036 Edwards, Hist. of West Indies, vol. i. p. 235, ed. 1801.

1037 Journ. of Asiat. Soc., Nos. xxv. and xxix., 1834.

1037 Journal of the Asiatic Society, Nos. 25 and 29, 1834.

1038 Ann. des Sci. Nat. tom. xxii. p. 117, Feb. 1831.

1038 Ann. des Sci. Nat. vol. xxii. p. 117, Feb. 1831.

1039 Malte-Brun's Geog., vol. i. p. 435.

1039 Malte-Brun's Geography, vol. i. p. 435.

1040 Bakewell, Travels in the Tarentaise, vol. i. p. 201.

1040 Bakewell, Travels in the Tarentaise, vol. i. p. 201.

1041 Nahum Ward, Trans. of Antiq. Soc. of Massachusetts. Holmes's United States, p. 438.

1041 Nahum Ward, Trans. of Antiq. Soc. of Massachusetts. Holmes's United States, p. 438.

1042 Bull. de la Soc. Géol. de France, tom. ii. p. 329.

1042 Bull. de la Soc. Géol. de France, vol. ii. p. 329.

1043 See above, p. 240.

See above, p. 240.

1044 See remarks by M. Boblaye, Ann. des Mines, 3me série, tom. iv.

1044 See comments by M. Boblaye, Ann. des Mines, 3rd series, vol. iv.

1045 Ann. des Mines, 3me série, tom. iv., 1833.

1045 Ann. des Mines, 3rd series, vol. iv., 1833.

1046 Bull. de la Soc. Géol. de France, tom. iii. p. 223.

1046 Bulletin of the Geological Society of France, volume iii, page 223.

1047 Mém. de la Soc. d'Hist, Nat. de Paris, tom. iv.

1047 Memoirs of the National History Society of Paris, vol. iv.

1048 Reliquiæ Diluvianæ, p. 108.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Deluge Remains, p. 108.

1049 Journ. de Géol., tom. i. p. 286. July, 1830.

1049 Journal of Geology, vol. 1, p. 286. July, 1830.

1050 Reliquiæ Diluvianæ, p. 165.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Deluge Remains, p. 165.

1051 M. Marcel de Serres, Géognosie des Terrains Tertiaires, p. 64. Introduction.

1051 M. Marcel de Serres, Geology of Tertiary Deposits, p. 64. Introduction.

1052 Bull. de la Soc. Géol. de France, tom. ii. pp. 56-63.

1052 Bull. de la Soc. Géol. de France, vol. ii, pp. 56-63.

1053 Desnoyers, Bull. de la Soc. Géol. de France, tom. ii. p. 252.

1053 Desnoyers, Bulletin de la Société Géologique de France, vol. ii, p. 252.

1054 Hist. Rom. Epit., lib. iii. c. 10.

1054 Hist. Rom. Epit., book iii, chapter 10.

1055 Buckland, Reliquiæ Diluvianæ, p. 25.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Buckland, Reliquiæ Diluvianæ, p. 25.

1056 See above, pp. 730, 731.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ See above, pp. 730, 731.

1057 On the Lake Mountains of North of England, Geol. Soc. Jan. 5, 1831.

1057 In the Lake Mountains of Northern England, Geol. Soc. Jan. 5, 1831.

1058 Notes on Geol. of Cuba, 1836, Phil. Mag., July, 1837.

1058 Notes on the Geology of Cuba, 1836, Philosophical Magazine, July, 1837.

1059 See above, p. 67.

See above, p. 67.

1060 Account of the Arctic Regions, vol. ii. p. 193.

1060 Account of the Arctic Regions, vol. ii. p. 193.

1061 Ibid. p. 202.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Same source, p. 202.

1062 Dr. Richardson's Geognost Obs. on Capt. Franklin's Polar Expedition.

1062 Dr. Richardson's Geognost Observations on Captain Franklin's Polar Expedition.

1063 Malte-Brun, Geog., vol. v. part 1. p. 112.—Brantz, Hist. of Greenland, tom. 1. pp. 53, 54.

1063 Malte-Brun, Geography, vol. 5, part 1, p. 112.—Brantz, History of Greenland, vol. 1, pp. 53, 54.

1064 Olafsen, Voyage to Iceland, tom. i.—Malte-Brun's Geog., vol. v. part i. p. 112.

1064 Olafsen, Voyage to Iceland, vol. 1.—Malte-Brun's Geography, vol. 5, part 1, p. 112.

1065 See above, pp. 303 and 323.

1065 See above, pp. 303 and 323.

1066 Geol. Trans., second series, vol. v. p. 212.

1066 Geol. Trans., second series, vol. 5, p. 212.

1067 Göppert, Poggendorff's Annalen der Physik und Chemie, vol. xxxviii. part iv., Leipsic, 1836. See also Lyell's Manual of Geol., p. 40.

1067 Göppert, Poggendorff's Annals of Physics and Chemistry, vol. 38, part 4, Leipzig, 1836. Also check out Lyell's Manual of Geology, p. 40.

1068 Trans. Geol. Soc., vol. iii. part i. p. 201, second series.

1068 Trans. Geol. Soc., vol. 3, part 1, p. 201, second series.

1069 Sir T. D. Lauder's Account, 2d. ed., p. 312.

1069 Sir T. D. Lauder's Account, 2nd ed., p. 312.

1070 Treatise on Practical Store Farming, p. 25.

1070 Treatise on Practical Store Farming, p. 25.

1071 Sir T. D. Lauder's Floods in Morayshire, 1829; and above, p. 196.

1071 Sir T. D. Lauder's Floods in Morayshire, 1829; and above, p. 196.

1072 Humboldt's Pers. Nar., vol. iv. p. 394.

1072 Humboldt's Personal Narrative, vol. iv, p. 394.

1073 Buenos Ayres and La Plata, p. 187.

1073 Buenos Aires and La Plata, p. 187.

1074 Malte-Brun's Geog., vol. iii. p. 22.

1074 Malte-Brun's Geog., vol. III, p. 22.

1075 This account I had from Mr. Baumhauer, Director-General of Finances in Java.

1075 I got this information from Mr. Baumhauer, the Director-General of Finances in Java.

1076 Tracts on India, p. 397.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Documents on India, p. 397.

1077 Scots Mag., vol. xxxiii.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Scots Magazine, vol. 33.

1078 Darwin's Journal, p. 372. 2d ed., 1845, p. 304.

1078 Darwin's Journal, p. 372. 2nd ed., 1845, p. 304.

1079 Narrative of Discovery in Egypt, &c., London, 1820.

1079 Narrative of Discovery in Egypt, etc., London, 1820.

1080 Scots Mag., vol. xxxiii., 1771.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Scots Magazine, vol. 33, 1771.

1081 Quart. Journ. of Agricult., No. ix p. 433.

1081 Quarterly Journal of Agriculture, No. 9, p. 433.

1082 Cæsar Moreau's Tables of the Navigation of Great Britain.

1082 Caesar Moreau's Tables for Navigating Great Britain.

1083 I give these results on the authority of Captain W. H. Smyth, R. N.

1083 I present these findings based on the authority of Captain W. H. Smyth, R. N.

1084 Von Hoff, vol. i. p. 379.

1084 Von Hoff, vol. i. p. 379.

1085 This account I received from the Honorable and Rev. Charles Harris.

1085 I got this account from the Honorable and Rev. Charles Harris.

1086 Von Hoff, vol. i. p. 368.

1086 Von Hoff, vol. i. p. 368.

1087 Lieut. Carless, Geograph. Journ., vol. viii. p. 338.

1087 Lieutenant Carless, Geographic Journal, vol. 8, p. 338.

1088 Silliman's Geol. Lectures, p. 78, who cites Penn.

1088 Silliman's Geology Lectures, p. 78, who cites Pennsylvania.

1089 Leigh's Lancashire, p. 17, A. D. 1700.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Leigh's Lancashire, p. 17, A.D. 1700.

1090 Geol. Trans., second series, vol. ii. p. 87.

1090 Geol. Trans., second series, vol. ii. p. 87.

1091 Phil. Trans., 1799.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Phil. Trans., 1799.

1092 Phil. Trans., vol. lxix., 1779.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Phil. Trans., vol. 69, 1779.

1093 Phil. Trans., 1826, part. ii. p. 55.

1093 Phil. Trans., 1826, part. ii. p. 55.

1094 See above, pp. 453. 457. 499. 501.

1094 See above, pp. 453, 457, 499, 501.

1095 Thomson's Western Himalaya and Thibet, p. 292. London, 1852. Cunningham, vol. xvii. Journ. Asiat. Soc. Bengal, pp. 241, 277.

1095 Thomson's Western Himalaya and Tibet, p. 292. London, 1852. Cunningham, vol. xvii. Journ. Asiat. Soc. Bengal, pp. 241, 277.

1096 Alciphron, or the Minute Philosopher, vol. ii. pp. 84, 85, 1732.

1096 Alciphron, or the Minute Philosopher, vol. ii. pp. 84, 85, 1732.

1097 Davy, Consolations in Travel, p. 276.

1097 Davy, Consolations in Travel, p. 276.

1098 Essay on the Vicissitude of Things.

1098 Essay on the Changes of Life.

1099 On Freshwater Marl, &c. By C. Lyell. Geol. Trans., vol. ii., second series, p. 73.

1099 form On Freshwater Marl, etc. By C. Lyell. Geol. Trans., vol. ii., second series, p. 73.

1100 See Desmarest's Crustacea, pl. 55.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ See Desmarest's Crustacea, plate 55.

1101 Dr. Bigsby, Journ. of Science, &c. No. xxxvii. pp. 262, 263.

1101 Dr. Bigsby, Journal of Science, etc. No. 37, pp. 262, 263.

1102 Mantell, Geol. of Sussex, p. 285; also Catalogue of Org. Rem., Geol. Trans., vol. iii. part i. p. 201., 2nd series.

1102 Mantell, Geology of Sussex, p. 285; also Catalog of Organic Remains, Geological Transactions, vol. iii. part i. p. 201., 2nd series.

1103 Page 276.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Page 276.

1104 Page 460.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Page 460.

1105 Page 599.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Page 599.

1106 Forchhammer, Report British Assoc. 1844.

1106 Forchhammer, Report of the British Association, 1844.

1107 Fleming's Brit. Animals, p. 37; in which work other cases are enumerated.

1107 Fleming's British Animals, p. 37; in this work, other cases are listed.

1108 Quart. Journ. of Lit. Sci., &c., No. xv., p. 172. Oct. 1819.

1108 Quarterly Journal of Literature and Science, etc., No. 15, p. 172. October 1819.

1109 This specimen has been presented by Mr. Lonsdale to the Geological Society of London.

1109 Mr. Lonsdale has presented this specimen to the Geological Society of London.

1110 The most conspicuous of the bones represented within the shell in fig. 107, appear to be the clavicle and coracoid bone. They are hollow; and for this reason resemble, at first sight, the bones of birds rather than of reptiles; for the latter have no medullary cavity. Prof. Owen, of the College of Surgeons, in order to elucidate this point, dissected for me a very young turtle, and found that the exterior portion only of the bones was ossified, the interior being still filled with cartilage. This cartilage soon dried up and shrank to a mere thread upon the evaporation of the spirits of wine in which the specimen had been preserved, so that in a short time the bones became as empty as those of birds.

1110 The most noticeable bones found within the shell in fig. 107 seem to be the clavicle and coracoid bone. They are hollow, which is why they initially look more like bird bones than reptile bones; reptiles don't have a medullary cavity. Professor Owen from the College of Surgeons dissected a very young turtle for me to clarify this. He discovered that only the outer part of the bones was ossified, while the inside was still filled with cartilage. This cartilage quickly dried up and shrank to a thin thread after the spirits of wine used for preservation evaporated, making the bones appear as empty as those of birds within a short period.

1111 Ehrenberg, Nat. und Bild. der Coralleninseln. &c., Berlin, 1834.

1111 Ehrenberg, Nat. and Picture of the Coral Islands. &c., Berlin, 1834.

1112 See Ehrenberg's work above cited, p. 751.

1112 See Ehrenberg's work mentioned above, p. 751.

1113 Stutchbury, West of England Journal, No. i. p. 49.

1113 Stutchbury, West of England Journal, No. 1, p. 49.

1114 Darwin's Coral Reefs, p. 77.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Darwin's Coral Reefs, p. 77.

1115 Ibid. 78.

Ibid. 78.

1116 Voyage to the Pacific, &c. in 1825-28.

1116 Journey to the Pacific, etc. in 1825-28.

1117 Darwin's Journal, &c., p. 540, and new edit., of 1845, p. 453.

1117 Darwin's Journal, & c., p. 540, and new edition, of 1845, p. 453.

1118 Darwin's Journal, &c., pp. 547, 548., and 2d edit., of 1845, p. 460.

1118 Darwin's Journal, &c., pp. 547, 548, and 2nd ed., of 1845, p. 460.

1119 Kotzebue's Voy., 1815-18, vol. iii. pp. 331-333.

1119 Kotzebue's Voy., 1815-18, vol. iii. pp. 331-333.

1120 Stutchbury, West of Eng. Journ., No. i. p. 50.

1120 Stutchbury, West of Eng. Journ., No. i. p. 50.

1121 Captain Beechey, part i. p. 188.

1121 Captain Beechey, part i. p. 188.

1122 Captain Moresby on the Maldives, Journ. Roy. Geograph. Soc., vol. V. part ii. p. 400.

1122 Captain Moresby on the Maldives, Journal of the Royal Geographical Society, vol. V, part ii, p. 400.

1123 See above, p. 442.

See above, p. 442.

1124 Darwin, Volcanic Islands, p. 113.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Darwin, Islands Formed by Volcanoes, p. 113.

1125 Quart. Journ. Geol. Soc. 4. XCIII.

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ Quart. Journ. Geol. Soc. 4. XCIII.

1126 Darwin's Journal, p. 557. 2d edit. chap. 20, and Coral Islands, chapters 1, 2, 3.

1126 Darwin's Journal, p. 557. 2nd edit. chap. 20, and Coral Islands, chapters 1, 2, 3.

1127 See Principles of Geology, 1st edit., vol. ii. p. 296.

1127 See Principles of Geology, 1st edit., vol. ii. p. 296.

1128 Voyage to the Pacific, &c., p. 189.

1128 Voyage to the Pacific, &c., p. 189.

1129 See Principles of Geology, 1st ed., 1832, vol. ii. p. 293.

1129 See Principles of Geology, 1st ed., 1832, vol. ii. p. 293.

1130 Beechey's Voyage to the Pacific, &c., p. 46.

1130 Beechey's Voyage to the Pacific, etc., p. 46.

1131 Voyage to the Pacific, &c., p. 194.

1131 Voyage to the Pacific, & etc., p. 194.

1132 Scotsman, Nov. 1842, and Jameson's Edin. Journ. of Science, 1843.

1132 Scotsman, Nov. 1842, and Jameson's Edin. Journ. of Science, 1843.

1133 Trans. Geol. Soc., London, 2d series, vol. v.

1133 Trans. Geol. Soc., London, 2nd series, vol. 5.

1134 Beechey's Voyage, vol. i. p. 45.

1134 Beechey's Voyage, vol. i. p. 45.

1135 Paper read to Brit. Assoc., Southampton, 1846.

1135 Paper presented to the British Association, Southampton, 1846.

1136 Letter to Mr. Maclaren, Scotsman, 1843.

1136 Letter to Mr. Maclaren, Scotsman, 1843.

INDEX.

A.

A.

  • Abich, M., on eruption of Vesuvius in 1834, 378, 380,, 550.
  • Abo, 522, 523.
  • Acosta cited, 499, 502.
  • Adams, Mr., on fossil elephant, 80.
  • Adanson on age of the baobab tree, 422.
  • Addison on Burnet's theory, 32.
  • Adige, embankment of the, 255.
  • ——, delta of the, 257.
  • Adour, R., new passage formed by, 338.
  • Adria, formerly a seaport, 256.
  • Adriatic, deposits in, 36, 88, 71, 257, 774.
  • Ægean Sea, Prof. E. Forbes dredging in, 649.
  • Africa, fossil shells of, mentioned by ancients, 15.
  • ——, indigenous quadrupeds of, 82.
  • ——, heat radiated by, 94.
  • ——, currents on coast of, 292, 342.
  • ——, drift sands of deserts, 726.
  • ——, devastations of locusts in, 674.
  • ——, strata forming off tropical coast of, 774.
  • ——, desert of its area, 694.
  • Agassiz, M., on fish of coal formation, 136.
  • ——, on abrupt transition from one fossil fauna to another, 184.
  • ——, on motion, &c., of glaciers, 224, 226.
  • Agricola on fossil remains, 21.
  • Airthrey, fossil whale found at, 771.
  • Alabama, coal plants, 88.
  • Alaska, volcanoes in, 352.
  • Aldborough, incursions of sea at, 311.
  • Alderney, race of, 293.
  • Aleutian Isles, eruptions, &c., in, 352, 468.
  • Alexandria, temple of Serapis at, 512.
  • Algæ, known provinces of, 617.
  • Allan, Dr., on coral in Madagascar, 778.
  • Alloa, whale cast ashore at, 771.
  • Alluvium, imbedding of organic remains in, 780.
  • ——, volcanic, 386.
  • ——, stalagmite, alternating with, in caves, 736.
  • Alps, Saussure on the, 45.
  • ——, tertiary rocks of the, 119.
  • ——, greatly raised during tertiary epoch, 124.
  • ——, signs of lateral pressure in the, 171.
  • Altered rocks, 177.
  • Amazon, R., land formed by its deposits, 342.
  • ——, animals floated down on drift-wood by, 640.
  • America, its coast undermined, 331.
  • ——, recent strata in lakes of, 254, 768.
  • ——, specific distinctness of animals of, 612, 629.
  • ——, domesticated animals run wild in, 585, 685.
  • ——, N., continuous beds of coal in, 115.
  • ——, N., deposit "New red" like English, 158.
  • ——, N. and S., mammiferous fauna of, 633.
  • Ammonia in lavas, 550.
  • Amonoosuck, flood in valley of, 209.
  • Ampère, M., on electric currents in the earth, 543.
  • Amphitherium, in oolite of Stonesfleld, 138.
  • Andes, changes of level in, 762.
  • ——, height of perpetual snow on, 112.
  • ——, volcanoes of, 346
  • ——, sudden upheaval of, 170.
  • ——, signs of lateral pressure in, 171.
  • Andesite, rock described, 347.
  • Angiospermous plants wanting in older rocks, 133.
  • Animals, extinction of, 700.
  • ——, quantity of food required by large, 82.
  • ——, Lamarck on production of new organs in, 568.
  • ——, imported into America have ran wild, 585, 685.
  • ——, aptitude of some kinds to domestication, 593, 598.
  • ——, hereditary instincts of, 593.
  • ——, domestic qualities of, 592, 595.
  • ——, their acquired habits rarely transmissible, 595, 600.
  • ——, changes in brain of fœtus in, 609.
  • ——, plants diffused by, 623.
  • ——, their geographical distribution, 76, 77.
  • ——, migrations of, 685.
  • ——, causes which determine the stations of, 669, 676.
  • ——, influence of man on their distribution, 682.
  • ——, fossil, in peat caves, &c., 722, 725, 730, 732, 749, 752.
  • Anio, R., flood of the, 212.
  • ——, travertin formed by, 244.
  • Anoplotherium, fossil of Isle of Wight, 142.
  • Antarctic circle, area still unexplored, 99.
  • Antwerp, sunk region near, 327.
  • Apennines, their relative age, 119, 124
  • Aphides, account of a shower of, 656.
  • ——, their multiplication, 673.
  • Aqueous causes, supposed former intensity of, 153.
  • ——, their action described, 198.
  • Aqueous lavas, description of, 374, 385, 728.
  • Arabian Gulf filling with coral, 776.
  • Arabian writers, 17.
  • Arago, M., on influence of forests on climate, 715.
  • ——, on solar radiation, 127.
  • ——, on level of Mediterranean and Red Sea, 294.
  • ——, on formation of ground ice, 221.
  • Araucanian tradition of a flood, 499.
  • Araucaria, fir in coal, 88.
  • Arbroath, houses, &c., swept away by sea at, 302.
  • Archiac, M., 257.
  • Arctic fauna extended farther south than now, 125.
  • Arduino, memoirs of, 41.
  • ——, on submarine volcanoes, 41, 71.
  • Areas of elevation and subsidence proved by coral islands, 792.
  • Aristarchus, 212.
  • Aristotle, opinions of, 12.
  • ——, on spontaneous generation, 22.
  • ——, on deluge of Deucalion, 356.
  • Arkansas, R., 264
  • ——, floods of, 270.
  • Arso, volcanic eruption of, in Ischia, 365.
  • Artesian well at Paris, temperature of water, 234.
  • ——, well, at Fort William, near Calcutta, 280.
  • ——, well in delta of Po, 257.
  • 818 Artesian wells near London, 234.
  • ——, wells, phenomena brought to light by, 233, 538.
  • Arve, sediment transported by the, 258.
  • ——, section of débris deposited by, 289.
  • Ascension, Island of, bounded by lofty shores, 622.
  • ——, fossil eggs of turtle from, 771.
  • Ashes, volcanic, transported to great distances, 106, 349, 464.
  • Asia, subject to earthquakes, 9.
  • ——, coast of, changed, 18.
  • ——, causes of extreme cold of part of, 94.
  • ——, Minor, gain of land on coast of, 260.
  • ——, Western, great cavity in, 692.
  • Ass, wild, 638, 686.
  • Astruc on Delta of Rhone, 258.
  • Atchafalaya, R., 264.
  • ——, drift-wood in, 267.
  • Atlantic, mean depth of, 104.
  • ——, its relative level, 294.
  • ——, rise of the tide in, 295.
  • ——, absence of coral reefs in, 796.
  • Atlantis, submersion of, 9.
  • Atolls described, 782, 786.
  • ——, theory of, Mr. Maclaren's objections to, 792.
  • Atrio del Cavallo, 381.
  • Aubenas, fissures filled with breccia near, 741.
  • Austen, Mr. R. A. C., on shores of English Channel, 319.
  • ——, on new strata formed in, 341.
  • Australia, animals of, 139, 143, 684.
  • ——, coral reefs of, 776, 784
  • ——, land quadrupeds of, 633.
  • Auvergne, salt springs in, 248.
  • ——, carbonic acid gas disengaged in, 248.
  • ——, state of in tertiary period, 122.
  • ——, fossils in volcanic ashes of, 349.
  • ——, volcanic rocks of, 48.
  • ——, tertiary red marl and sandstone of, 158.
  • Ava, fossils of, 28.
  • Avantipura, in Cashmere, 763.
  • Avernus lake, 368.
  • Avicenna on cause of mountains, 17.
  • Axmouth, great landslip near, 321.
  • Azores, icebergs drifted to, 99.
  • ——, volcanic line from, to central Asia, 354
  • ——, siliceous springs of, 246.

B.

B.

  • Babbage, Mr., on the coast near Puzzuoli, 507.
  • ——, on Temple of Serapis, 517.
  • ——, on expansion of rocks by heat, 562.
  • Bachman, Mr., on birds, 643, 644.
  • Bacon, Lord, cited, 765.
  • Baden, gypseous springs of, 245.
  • Baffin's Bay, icebergs in, 96.
  • Bagnes, valley of, bursting of a lake in the, 210.
  • Baiæ, changes on coast of the bay of, 507.
  • ——, ground plan of the coast of, 507.
  • ——, sections in bay of, 508, 510.
  • Baker, on Caspian, mud volcanoes at, 448.
  • Baker, Lieut., on fossil quadrumana, 144.
  • Bakewell, Mr., on formation of soils, 709.
  • ——, on fall of Mount Grenier, 782.
  • Bakewell, Mr. jun., on Falls of Niagara, 217.
  • Bakie loch, charæ fossil in, 767.
  • Baku, inflammable gas of, 11, 355.
  • Balaruc, thermal waters of, 259.
  • Baldassari, on Sienese fossils, 39.
  • Balize, mouth of Mississippi, 263, 272.
  • Baltic Sea, lowering of level of, 520.
  • ——, drifting of rocks by ice in, 219, 231.
  • ——, currents on its shores, 330.
  • Banks of Mississippi higher than alluvial plain, 266.
  • Baobab tree, its size, probable age, &c., 422.
  • Barbadoes, rain diminished by felling of forests in, 713.
  • Barren Island described, 447.
  • Barrow, Mr., on a bank formed in sea by locusts, 675.
  • Barrow, Mr. jun., on the Geysers of Iceland, 247.
  • Barton, Mr., on geography of plants, 612.
  • Basalt, opinions of the early writers on, 48, 71.
  • Batavia, effects of earthquake at, 502.
  • Baton Rouge, in Louisiana, 265.
  • Bay of Bengal, its depth, recent deposits in, &c., 279.
  • Bayfield, Capt., on geology of Lake Superior, 254.
  • ——, on drifting of rock by ice, 221, 230.
  • ——, on bursting of a peninsula by Lake Erie, 333.
  • ——, on earthquakes in Canada, 470.
  • Beaches, raised, 184.
  • Beachey Head, 317.
  • Bears, once numerous in Wales, 683.
  • ——, black, migrations of, 637.
  • ——, drifted on ice, 679.
  • Beaufort, Sir F., on gain of land in Asia Minor, 260.
  • ——, on rise of tides, 291.
  • Beaumont, M. Elie de, geological map of France, 122.
  • ——, on pentagonal network of mountain chains, 170.
  • ——, his theory of contemporaneous origin of parallel mountain chains considered, 163.
  • ——, on structure and origin of Etna, 400, 416.
  • ——, on sand-dunes, 307.
  • ——, on inroads of sea in Holland, 327.
  • Beaver once inhabited Scotland and Wales, 683.
  • ——, fossil in Perthshire, 752.
  • ——, lake formed by, in New Brunswick, 716.
  • Beche, Sir H. de la. See De la Beche.
  • Bee, migrations of the, 655.
  • Beechey, Capt., upheaval of Bay of Conception, 500.
  • ——, on drifting of canoes, 662.
  • ——, on temple of Ipsambul, 727.
  • ——, on coral islands, 780, 782, 787.
  • ——, on changes of level in Pacific, 788.
  • ——, on dead coral in Elizabeth Island, 794.
  • Beila, in India, mud volcanoes, 449.
  • Belcher, Sir E., on upheaval of Conception, 500.
  • ——, on strata forming off coast of Africa, 774.
  • Bell, Mr., on the Dog, 585.
  • Bell rock, stones thrown up by storms on, 302.
  • Belzoni, on temple of Ipsambul, 726.
  • ——, on a flood of the Nile, 753.
  • Benin, currents in Bay of, 292.
  • Bérard, M., on depth and temperature of Mediterranean, 296, 336.
  • Berkeley, on recent origin of man, 764.
  • Bermudas, only coral reef far out in Atlantic, 796.
  • ——, coral reefs of the, 776, 778.
  • Bewick cited, 310, 643, 683.
  • Bhooj, in Cutch, destroyed by earthquake, 459.
  • ——, volcanic eruption at, 460, 729.
  • Bies Bosch formed, 328.
  • Bigsby, Dr., on North American lakes, 768.
  • Birds, diffusion of plants by, 624.
  • ——, geographical distribution of, 642, 663.
  • ——, fossils in secondary rocks, 137.
  • ——, tameness of, in uninhabited Islands, 597.
  • ——, rate of flight of, 644.
  • ——, migrations of, 643.
  • ——, recent extermination of some species of, 683.
  • ——, bones of, in Gibraltar breccia, 741.
  • ——, rarity of their remains in new strata, 748.
  • ——, rare in deposits of all ages, 137.
  • Bischoff, Professor, on volcanoes, 551.
  • ——, on carbonic acid in extinct craters on Rhine, 248.
  • Biscoe, Capt., discoveries in south Polar Seas, 99.
  • Bison, fossil, in Yorkshire, 76.
  • Bisons, in Mississippi valley, 636.
  • Bistineau lake, 269.
  • Bitumen, oozing from bottom of sea, near Trinidad, 250.
  • Bituminous springs, 250.
  • Black Sea, salt by evaporation in, 335.
  • ——. See Euxine.
  • Blue mountains in Jamaica, 505.
  • 819 Bluffs of Mississippi described, 264.
  • Boa constrictor, migration of, 646.
  • Boase, Mr., on inroads of sea in Cornwall, 323.
  • ——, on drift-sand in Cornwall, 728.
  • Boblaye, M., on ceramique, in Morea, 731.
  • ——, on engulfed rivers and caves in Morea, 734.
  • ——, on earthquakes in Greece, 736.
  • Bog iron-ore, whence derived, 722.
  • Bogota, earthquake of, 457.
  • Bonpland, on plants common to Old and New World, 614.
  • Bore, a tidal wave frequent in Bristol Channel and Ganges, 332.
  • Bory de St. Vincent, M., on isle of Santorin, 445.
  • Bosphorus, 334.
  • ——, traditions of deluges on shores of the, 356.
  • Botanical evidence bearing on theory of progressive development, 133.
  • ——, geography, 613.
  • ——, provinces, their number, 616, 666, 668.
  • Bothnia, Gulf, gradual elevation of coast of, 520.
  • Bourbon, island, volcanic, 546.
  • Bournmouth, submarine forest at, 746.
  • Boussingault. M., on volcanoes in Andes, 348.
  • ——, on gases evolved by volcanoes, 549.
  • Bowen, Lieut., on drifting of rocks by ice, 220, 230.
  • Boyle, on bottom of the sea, 26.
  • Bracini, on Vesuvius before 1631, 374.
  • Brahmapootra, delta of, 275, 278.
  • Brahmins, their doctrines, 4.
  • Brander, on fossils of Hampshire, 46.
  • Brandt, Professor, cited, 80.
  • ——, on Wilui rhinoceros, 80.
  • Bravais, M., on upraised sea-coast in Finmark, 530.
  • Breccias, in Val del Bove, 411.
  • ——, in caves now forming in the Morea, 734.
  • Brenta, delta of the, 256.
  • Brieslak, on temple of Serapis, 517.
  • ——, on Vesuvius, 381, 384.
  • Briggs, Mr., his discovery of water in African desert, 235.
  • Brighton, waste of cliffs of, 317.
  • Brine springs, 247.
  • Bristol Channel, currents in, 293.
  • Brittany, village, buried under blown sand, 727.
  • ——, marine tertiary strata of, 122.
  • ——, waste of coast of, 324.
  • Brocchi, on fossil conchology, 20.
  • ——, on Burnet's theory, 34.
  • ——, on delta of Po, 257.
  • ——, on extinction of species, 668.
  • ——, on the Subapennines, 118.
  • Broderip, Mr., on opossum of Stonesfield, 139.
  • ——, on shells from Conception Bay, 500.
  • ——, on bulimi revived, 650.
  • ——, on moulting of crabs, 653.
  • ——, on naturalization of a foreign landshell, 664.
  • ——, on the Dodo, 684.
  • Brongniart, M. Adolphe, 87.
  • ——, on fossil plants of coal, 88, 117, 133.
  • ——, on plants in islands, 112.
  • Brongniart, M. Alex., on modern lava streams, 427.
  • ——, on elevated beaches in Sweden, 527.
  • Brown, Mr. R., on structure of vessels in myzodendron, 88.
  • ——, on plants common to Africa, Guiana, and
  • Brazil, 621.
  • ——, on wheat in Egyptian tombs, 587.
  • Buch. See Von Buch.
  • Buckland, Rev. Dr., on landslip near Axmouth, 321.
  • ——, on fossil elephants, &c., in India, 7.
  • ——, on fossils from Eschscholtz's Bay, 82.
  • ——, on fossils in caves and fissures, 739, 740.
  • ——, on Val del Bove, 402.
  • Buffon, his theory of the earth, 39.
  • ——, reproved by the Sorbonne, 39.
  • ——, on geographical distribution of animals, 590, 612, 629.
  • ——, on extinction of species, 701.
  • Buist, Mr., on submarine forests in the estuary of Tay, 303.
  • ——, on mud volcanoes in India, 448.
  • Bunbury, Mr., on coal plants of Alabama, 88.
  • ——, on ferns in carboniferous era, 87.
  • Bunsen, Chevalier, on Ancient Egypt, 659.
  • Bunsen, Professor, on Geysers of Iceland, 558.
  • ——, on mineral springs in Iceland, 246.
  • ——, on mud volcanoes of Iceland, 447.
  • ——, on solfataras of Iceland, 551.
  • Bunter Sandstein, fossils of, 193.
  • Bura, submerged Grecian town, 15, 762.
  • Buried cones on Etna, section of, 397.
  • ——, temples of Cashmere, 762.
  • Burnes, Sir A., on Cutch, earthquake of, 461, 464.
  • Burnet, his theory of the earth, 31.
  • Burntisland, whale cast ashore near, 771.
  • Burrampooter, R., delta of the, 275. See Brahmapootra.
  • ——, bodies of men, deer, &c. floated off by, 751.
  • Bustards recently extirpated in England, 688.

C.

C.

  • Calabria, geological description of, 474.
  • ——, earthquake of 1783 in, 471.
  • ——, tertiary strata of, 74.
  • Calanna, lava of Etna turned from its course by hill of, 409, 410.
  • ——, valley of, 402, 404.
  • Calcareous springs, 239.
  • Calcutta, artesian well at, 280.
  • Caldcleugh, Mr., on earthquake in Chili, 1835, 453.
  • ——, on eruption of Coseguina, 349.
  • California, volcanoes in, 349.
  • Callao town destroyed by sea, 502.
  • ——, changes caused by earthquakes at, 501, 761.
  • Camels, carcasses of, imbedded in drift sand, 727.
  • Campagna di Roma, calcareous deposits of, 242.
  • Campania, aqueous lavas in, 728.
  • Camper, on facial angle, 608.
  • Canada, earthquakes frequent in, 470.
  • ——, climate of, 582.
  • ——, probably colder in newest tertiary period, 125.
  • Canary Islands, eruptions in, 436.
  • Cannon in calcareous rock, 759.
  • ——, account of one taken up near the Downs, 726.
  • Canoes drifted to great distances, 661.
  • ——, fossil, 759.
  • Cape May, encroachment of sea at, 332.
  • ——, of Good Hope, icebergs seen off, 100.
  • Capocci, M., on temple of Serapis, 518.
  • Caraccas, earthquakes in, 465, 470.
  • Carang Assam volcano, 465.
  • Carbonated springs, 248.
  • Carbonic acid, supposed atmosphere of, 248.
  • ——, gas, its effects on rocks, 249.
  • Carboniferous series, 115, 137.
  • ——, era, predominance of ferns in, 87.
  • ——, era, climate in, 87.
  • ——, flora, knowledge of, recently acquired, 126.
  • ——, period, vast duration of, 249.
  • ——, See Coal.
  • Cardiganshire, tradition of loss of land in, 324.
  • Cardium, locomotive powers when young, 652.
  • Caribbean Sea, tides in, 342.
  • Carpenter, Dr., observations on Mississippi R., 272.
  • ——, on encroachment of sea at Lyme Regis, 321.
  • Carrara marble, 177.
  • Cashmere, temples buried in freshwater strata, 762.
  • Caspian, Pallas on former extent of, 45.
  • ——, evaporation of the, 260.
  • ——, its level, 156, 692.
  • Catalonia, devastation of torrents in, 713.
  • Catania, in part overwhelmed by lava, 400, 728.
  • ——, destroyed by earthquakes, 503.
  • ——, tools discovered in digging a well at, 753.
  • Catastrophes, theories respecting, 7.
  • Catcott, on deluges in different countries, 42.
  • Cattegat, devastations caused by current in the, 331.
  • 820 Cautley, Capt., on buried Hindoo town, 731.
  • ——, on fossil quadrumana, 144.
  • ——, on bones in ancient wells, 740.
  • Caves, organic remains in, 732.
  • ——, alternations of, and stalagmite in, 736.
  • ——, on Etna, 401.
  • Celestial Mountains, 77, 355.
  • Celsius, on diminution of Baltic, 33, 521.
  • Central America, volcanoes of, 349.
  • ——, Asia, volcanic line from, to the Azores, 354.
  • ——, France, lavas excavated in, 213.
  • ——, France, comparison between the lavas of Iceland and, 426, 427.
  • Centres, specific doctrine of, 630.
  • Centrifugal force, 534, 544.
  • Cephalonia, earthquakes in, 474.
  • ——, infusoria in submarine caverns in, 389.
  • Cesalpino, on organic remains, 22.
  • Cetacea, geographical range of, 635.
  • ——, migrations of the, 642.
  • ——, imbedding of, in recent strata, 770.
  • ——, fossil, absence of in secondary rocks, 145.
  • ——, fossil in New Jersey chalk, 145.
  • ——, rarity of in secondary rocks, 145.
  • Chagos coral isles, 783.
  • Chaluzet, calcareous spring at, 239.
  • ——, volcanic cone of, 248.
  • Chambers, Robert, cited, 530.
  • Chamisso, M., on coral islands, 781.
  • Chamouni, glaciers of, 223.
  • Chara, growing in lakes of N. America, 768.
  • Charæ, fossilized, 767.
  • Charlevoix, chart of coast of Gulf of Mexico, 272.
  • Charpentier, M., on glaciers, 223, 227.
  • Cheirotherium, in old red sandstone and coal, 136.
  • Chemical theory of volcanoes, 542, 546.
  • Chepstow, rise of the tides at, 291.
  • Cheshire, brine springs of, 247.
  • ——, waste of coast of, 324.
  • Chesil bank, 320.
  • Chesilton, overwhelmed by sea, 320.
  • Chili, earthquakes in, 65, 347, 357, 453, 457.
  • ——, numerous volcanoes in, 346.
  • ——, coast of, upheaved, 170, 172, 347, 455, 457.
  • Chiloe, 349.
  • Chimborazo, height of, 102.
  • China, climate of, 95.
  • ——, earthquakes in, 355.
  • Chinese deluge, 7.
  • Chines, or narrow ravines, described, 319.
  • Chittagong, earthquakes at, 476.
  • Chockier, cave at, 736.
  • Chonos archipelago, rise of land in, 453.
  • Christchurch Head promontory, 319.
  • Christie, Mr., on plasticity of ice, 226.
  • Christol, M. de, on fossils in caves, 738, 739.
  • Chronology of Hebrew Scriptures, 659.
  • ——, of Dr. Hales, 659.
  • Cimbrian deluge, 331.
  • Cisterna on Etna, how formed, 414.
  • Cities engulfed, 173.
  • Civita Vecchia, springs at, 243.
  • Clarke, Dr., on lava in motion, 377.
  • Cleavage, or slaty structure, 176.
  • Clermont, calcareous springs at, 239.
  • Climate of Europe, Raspe on former, 43.
  • ——, changes of 75, 86.
  • ——, change of, in northern hemisphere, 73, 123.
  • ——, on causes of vicissitudes in, 92.
  • ——, astronomical causes of fluctuations in, 126.
  • ——, its influence on distribution of plants, 613.
  • ——, effect of changes in, on range of species, 696.
  • ——, influence of vegetation on, 713.
  • Climates, insular and excessive, 94.
  • Coal, modern, at mouths of Mackenzie, 743.
  • ——, ancient beds, formed of plants, 90.
  • ——, ancient, formed in deltas, 116.
  • ——, fields, American, 115.
  • ——, formed by plants which grow on the spot, 115.
  • ——, period, warmth, moisture, &c. of climate, 126.
  • ——, formation, fossil plants of the, 88, 115, 133.
  • ——, climate indicated by, 91.
  • ——, reptilian fossils in, 136.
  • ——. See Carboniferous.
  • Colchester, Mr. W., on fossil quadrumana, 144.
  • Colebrooke, Mr. H. T., on age of Vedas, 4.
  • ——, on crocodiles of the Ganges, 277.
  • ——, Major R. H., on the Ganges, 277.
  • Colle, travertin of, 240.
  • Colombia, earthquakes in, 456.
  • Colonna, on organic remains, 23.
  • Columbia, R., submerged forest in, 270.
  • Conception, earthquakes at, 453, 456, 499, 761.
  • Conglomerates, now formed by rivers, &c., 289.
  • ——, volcanic, 411, 438.
  • Coniferæ of coal, 133.
  • ——, Araucarian, in coal, 88.
  • Consolidation of strata, 175.
  • Conybeare, Rev. W. D., on Lister, 26.
  • ——, on landslip near Axmouth, 321, 322
  • Cook, Captain, on drifting of canoes far, 661.
  • ——, on highland near the South Pole, 98, 99.
  • Copaic lake, 735.
  • Copernican theory, edicts against, repealed at Rome, 56.
  • Copiapo, earthquakes at, 347.
  • ——, raised banks of shells at, 458.
  • Coral islands, 775, 776, 793.
  • ——, origin of their circular form, 783.
  • ——, linear direction of, 782.
  • ——, rate of growth, 776.
  • ——, downward movement slow and uniform, 791.
  • ——, absence of, in Atlantic, &c., 796.
  • Coralline crag fossils, 142.
  • Corda, on palm wood in Bohemian coal, 88.
  • ——, cited, 133.
  • Cordier, M., on rate of increase of heat in mines, 538, 539.
  • ——, his theory on central heat and fluidity, 540.
  • ——, on tides in the internal melted ocean, 541.
  • Cordilleras shaken by earthquakes, 457, 466.
  • ——, parallel ridges successively upheaved, 170.
  • Corinth, decomposition of rocks in, 733.
  • Cornwall, waste of cliffs of, 323.
  • ——, land inundated by drift-sand in, 727.
  • ——, temperature of mines in, 538.
  • Coromandel, inundations of sea on coast of, 730.
  • Coseguina volcano, great eruption of, 347.
  • Cosmogony distinct from geology, 3.
  • ——, of the Hindoos, 4.
  • ——, Egyptian, 8.
  • ——, of the Koran, 18.
  • Cosmopolite shells, 650.
  • Coste, Capt., on elevation caused by earthquakes, 453.
  • Cotopaxi, 348, 560.
  • Covelli, M., on hot spring in Ischia, 456.
  • ——, on Vesuvian minerals, 385.
  • Cowper, the poet, on age of earth, 55.
  • Crag strata, fossils of the, 142.
  • Craters of elevation, theory of, 371, 380, 415.
  • Crawfurd, Mr., his discovery of fossils in Ava, 28.
  • ——, on eruption in Sumbawa, 106, 464, 465.
  • ——, on drifting of canoes, 662.
  • Creation, supposed centres or foci of, 667.
  • ——, epoch of, difference of opinion on, 660.
  • Cremona, lakes filled up near, 255.
  • Crocodiles imbedded by a river inundation in Java, 503, 748.
  • Cromer, waste of cliffs of, 306.
  • Cropthorn, fossils found at, 76.
  • Cruickshanks, Mr. A., on Chilian earthquake, 457.
  • Cuba, fossils in caves of, 741.
  • Culver, cliff, 318.
  • Cumana, earthquake of, 470.
  • Cunningham, Major, on buried temples of Cashmere, 764.
  • Cupressus thyoides, 725.
  • Currents from equatorial regions, 96.
  • ——, from the pole to the equator, 107.
  • ——, causes and velocity of, 293.
  • ——, polar and tropical, direction of, 295.
  • ——, destroying and transporting power of, 297, 340.
  • ——, in estuaries, their power, 337.
  • ——, in the Straits of Gibraltar, 333.
  • 821Currents, reproductive effects of, 337.
  • ——, on the British shores, 339.
  • ——, convey species from Antarctic to Arctic Ocean, 622.
  • Curtis, Mr., on ravages caused by aphides, 674.
  • ——, on power of the Tipulæ to cross the sea, 657.
  • ——, on number of British insects, 705.
  • ——, on fossil insects, 748.
  • Curves of the Mississippi, 265.
  • Cutch, changes caused by earthquake of 1819 in, 469, 761.
  • Cuvier on durability of bones of men, 147, 757.
  • ——, on crocodiles of Ganges, 277.
  • ——, on variability in species, 583, 584.
  • ——, on fish not crossing the Atlantic, 647.
  • ——, on identity of Egyptian mummies with living species, 586.
  • ——, on number of fishes, 705.
  • Cuvier, M. F., on aptitude of some animals to domestication, 593.
  • ——, on influence of domestication, 595.
  • Cypris, fossil and living, 768.

D.

D.

  • Dana, Mr., on Sandwich Islands, 354, 372, 383, 548.
  • ——, on fragments of recent coral thrown up by Polynesian volcanoes, 372.
  • ——, on Mount Loa, volcano, 552.
  • ——, on "volcanoes no safety-valves," 552.
  • Dangerfield, Capt F., on buried cities In India, 729.
  • ——, on Onjein, 729.
  • Daniell, Professor, on the trade winds, 106.
  • ——, on melting point of iron, 539.
  • Dante cited, 52, 256.
  • Dantzic, waste of land near, 331.
  • Darby, on lakes formed by Red River, 269.
  • ——, on delta of Mississippi, 272.
  • Darwin, Mr. C., on distribution of animals and plants, 77, 98, 141.
  • ——, on vegetation required for support of large quadrupeds, 82.
  • ——, Mr. C., on drifting of rocks by ice, 228.
  • ——, on earthquakes, 347, 458, 456, 476, 753.
  • ——, on earthquake waves, 497.
  • ——, on rise of land, 458, 502.
  • ——, on oolitic travertin, 439.
  • ——, on great droughts in S. America, 696.
  • ——, on peat of S. America, 719.
  • ——, on coral islands, 779, 780, 782, 785, 789.
  • ——, geology of S. America, 170.
  • ——, on recent shells in Chili, 190.
  • ——, on shingle on coast of S. America, 342.
  • ——, map of coral reefs, 352, 791, 794.
  • ——, on crateriform hills of Galapagos, 372.
  • ——, infusoria brought home by, 388.
  • ——, on new islands forming in Atlantic, 436.
  • ——, on nat. hist. of Galapagos, 141, 597, 615, 616, 642.
  • ——, on extinction of animals, 700.
  • Daubeny, Dr., on springs, 237.
  • ——, on Mount Vultur, 356.
  • ——, on Vesuvius, 380.
  • ——, on decomposition of trachyte, 385.
  • ——, on flowing of lava under water, 383.
  • ——, on volcanoes, 548, 549, 550, 551.
  • D'Aubuisson cited, 58, 411.
  • Davis, Mr., on Chinese deluge, 7.
  • Davy, Sir H., on lake of the Solfatara, 243.
  • ——, on formation of travertin, 243.
  • ——, on theory of progressive development, 131.
  • ——, on eruption of Vesuvius, 378.
  • ——, on chemical agency of electricity, 542.
  • ——, his theory of unoxidated metallic nucleus, 546.
  • ——, on agency of air and water in volcanoes, 548, 550.
  • ——, his analysis of peat, 718.
  • Davy, Dr., on Graham Island, 436, 549.
  • ——, on helmet taken from sea near Corfu, 760.
  • De Beaumont. See Beaumont, De.
  • Debey, Dr., of Aix, on cretaceous dicotyledons, 133.
  • De Candolle, on hybrid plants, 605.
  • ——, on distribution of plants, 613, 616.
  • ——, on agency of man in dispersion of plants, 625.
  • ——, on stations of plants, 670.
  • ——, on barriers separating botanical provinces, 703.
  • ——, on number of land plants, 705.
  • ——, on longevity of trees, 422.
  • Dechen, Von, map of Germany, &c., 123.
  • Dee, R., bridge over, swept away by floods, 208.
  • Deer, their powers of swimming, 636.
  • ——, diminished number in Great Britain, 683.
  • ——, remains of, in marl lakes, 752.
  • De la Beche, Sir H., on rocks in S. Wales, 91.
  • ——, on delta of Rhone in Lake of Geneva, 253.
  • ——, on storm of Nov., 1824, 321.
  • ——, on submarine forests, 323.
  • ——, on earthquake of Jamaica, 1692, 504.
  • ——, on action of rain in the tropics, 713.
  • De la Hire, on fossil wood from Ava, 1692, 28.
  • Delhi territory, elephants in, 81.
  • Delta of the Adige and Brenta, 256.
  • ——, of the Brahmapootra or Burrampooter, 275.
  • ——, of the Ganges, 275 to 284.
  • ——, of the Mississippi, 263 to 275.
  • ——, of the Mississippi, antiquity of. 271.
  • ——, of the Nile, 261.
  • ——, of the Po, 256.
  • ——, of Rhone, in Lake of Geneva, 252.
  • ——, of Rhone, in Mediterranean, 258.
  • Deltas, chronological computations of age of, 253, 285.
  • ——, of Lake Superior, 253.
  • ——, grouping of strata in, 286.
  • De Luc, his treatise on Geology, 56.
  • ——, on conversion of forests into peat mosses, 721.
  • De Luc, M. G. A., his natural chronometers, 726.
  • Deluge, ancient theories on, 18, 23, 25, 31, 42, 155.
  • ——, fossil shells referred to the, 20.
  • Deluges, local, how caused, 7, 269.
  • ——, traditions of different, 7, 11, 42, 331, 356, 500, 501.
  • Demaillet, speculative views of, 572.
  • Denudation can only keep pace with deposition, 154.
  • ——, effects of, 708.
  • Deposition of sediment, shifting of the area of, 188.
  • ——, and denudation parts of the same process, 154.
  • Deshayes, M., on fossils of tertiary, 184.
  • Desmarest, his definition of geology, 3.
  • ——, on Auvergne, 49.
  • Desnoyers, M., on human remains in caves, 739.
  • Desor, M., on glacier motion, 224.
  • Deucalion's deluge, 12.
  • Deville, M., on contraction of granite, 173.
  • ——, on trachytes, 440.
  • Devonian strata formed in deep seas, 117.
  • Diatomaceæ, 388.
  • Dikes, composition and position of, 379.
  • ——, how caused, 379.
  • Diluvial waves, no signs of on Etna, 423.
  • ——, theory of earlier geologists, 25.
  • Diodorus Siculus cited, 357.
  • Dion Cassius cited, 364.
  • Dodo, recent extinction of the, 684.
  • Dog, varieties of the, 570, 584.
  • ——, hybrids between wolf and, 601.
  • ——, acquired instincts hereditary in, 593.
  • ——, has run wild in America, 686.
  • Doggerbank, 340.
  • Dollart, formation of estuary of the, 329.
  • Dolomieu on Val di Noto, Vicentin, and Tyrol, 49.
  • ——, on lavas of Etna, 49.
  • ——, on decomposition of granite, 249.
  • ——, on earthquake of 1783 in Calabria, 473, 475, 478, 480.
  • Domestication, aptitude of some animals for, 593, 599.
  • ——, influence of, 595.
  • 822Don, river, rocks transported by, 208.
  • Donati on bed of Adriatic, 38, 71, 774.
  • Donny, Mr., cited, 557.
  • D'Orbigny, M. A., on abrupt transition from one fossil fauna to another, 184.
  • Dorsetshire, landslip in, 321.
  • ——, waste of cliffs of, 319.
  • Dove, Mr., map of isothermal lines, 93.
  • Dover, waste of chalk cliffs of, 314.
  • ——, depth of sea near, 315.
  • ——, formation of Straits of, 315.
  • ——, strata at foot of cliffs of, 314.
  • Downham buried by blown sand, 727.
  • Dranse, R., 210.
  • Drift, northern, fossil marine shells in, 186.
  • Drift-sand, fossils in, 727.
  • Drift-wood of Mississippi, 268.
  • ——, abundant in North Sea, 744.
  • Drontheim, 529.
  • Droughts in S. America, animals destroyed by, 696.
  • Druids, their doctrines, 16.
  • Dufresnoy, M., geological map of France, 122.
  • ——, on formation of Monte Nuovo, 371, 372.
  • ——, on tuffs of Somma, 382.
  • ——, on lavas of Vesuvius, 384.
  • Dujardin, M., on shells, &c., brought up by artesian well at Tours, 236.
  • Dumont, M., cited, 120, 328.
  • Dumoulin, M.. on earthquakes in Chili, 453.
  • Dunes, hills of blown sand, 305, 307.
  • Dunwich destroyed by the sea, 310.
  • Durand, Lieut., on fossil quadrumana, 144
  • Dureau de la Malle, M., cited, 584, 593.
  • Durham, waste of coast of, 303.
  • D'Urville, Capt, on temperature of Mediterranean, 296.

E.

E.

  • Earth, antiquity of the, 21.
  • ——, on changes in its axis, 80.
  • ——, proportion of land and sea on surface, 125.
  • ——, spheroidal form of the, 534.
  • ——, mean density of the, 535.
  • ——, attempt to calculate thickness of its crust, 536.
  • Earth, electric currents in the, 543.
  • ——, sections of the (see figs. 70, 71), 539.
  • ——, effects produced by powers of vitality on surface, 708.
  • Earthquakes, chronologically described, 458, et seq.
  • ——, energy of, probably uniform, 58.
  • ——, earth's surface continually remodelled by, 102.
  • ——, recurrence of, at stated periods, accidental, 345.
  • ——, felt at sea, 358.
  • ——, land elevated by, 458, 455, 457, 462.
  • ——, all countries liable to slight shocks of, 358.
  • ——, phenomena attending, 452.
  • ——, in Cutch, 1819 (see Map), 460.
  • ——, in Calabria, 1783, 471.
  • ——, difficulty of measuring the effects of, 477.
  • ——, chasms formed by, 479.
  • ——, excavation of valleys aided by, 488.
  • ——, renovating effects of, 565.
  • ——, cause of the wave-like motion of, 475, 558.
  • ——, cause of great waves and retreat of sea during, 496, 498.
  • ——, ravages caused by sea during, 499, 501, 730.
  • ——, connection between state of atmosphere and, 561.
  • ——, people entombed in caverns during, 736.
  • ——, causes of volcanoes and, 533.
  • ——, recurrence of, in certain zones of country, 172.
  • ——, of Lisbon, area over which it extended, 496.
  • ——, more frequent in winter, 561.
  • Eccles, old church of, buried under blown sand, 306.
  • Edmonstone Island, 279.
  • Eels, migration of, 647.
  • Egypt nearly exempt from earthquakes, 9, 358.
  • Egypt, towns buried under drift-sand in, 726.
  • ——, date of civilization of, according to Bunsen, 636.
  • Egyptian cosmogony, 8.
  • ——, mummies identical with living species, 585
  • Ehrenberg, on Bengal tiger in Siberia, 77.
  • ——, on origin of bog-iron ore, 722.
  • ——, on corals of Red Sea, 777.
  • ——, on ashes enveloping Pompeii, 388.
  • ——, on infusoria in volcanic tuff, 389.
  • Electricity, a source of volcanic heat, 542.
  • ——, whence derived, 543.
  • Elephant, fossil, in ice, 45, 80.
  • ——, covered with hair in Delhi, 81.
  • ——, sagacity of, not attributable to intercourse with man, 598.
  • ——, their powers of swimming, 636.
  • Elevation of land, how caused, 29, 448, 444, 453, 455, 457.
  • ——, proofs of, slow and gradual, 170, 184, 518, 563.
  • Elevation and subsidence, proportion of, 564.
  • ——, alternate areas of, in Pacific, 790.
  • Elevation crater theory, 371, 380, 420.
  • Elevation, valleys of, 420.
  • Elizabeth or Henderson's Island, upraised atoll of, 788, 794.
  • Elsa, travertin formed by the, 239.
  • Embankment, system of, in Italy, 255.
  • Emu in Australia will become exterminated, 684.
  • Englehardt on the Caspian Sea, 157.
  • England, waste of cliffs on coast of, 303.
  • ——, slight earthquakes felt in, 358.
  • ——, height of tides on coast of, 291, 308.
  • ——, tertiary strata of, 76.
  • Eocene period, fossils of the, 142, 144, 183.
  • Epomeo, Mount, in Ischia, 362.
  • Equatorial current, 95.
  • Equinoxes, precession of the, 100, 537.
  • Erebus, Mount, the active volcano of, 99.
  • Erie, Lake, peninsula cut through by, 333.
  • ——, waste of cliffs in, 333.
  • Erman, M., on eruptions in Kamschatka, 353.
  • Erratic blocks, 122, 154, 220.
  • ——, icebergs charged with, 86.
  • Erratic blocks, submarine, laid dry by upheaval, 229.
  • Eruptions, volcanic, number of per year, 450.
  • ——, cause of, 533.
  • Erzgebirge, mica slate of the, 48.
  • Escher, M., on flood in valley of Bagnes, 211.
  • Eschscholtz Bay, fossils of, 82.
  • Essex, tertiary strata of, 76.
  • ——, inroads of sea on coast of, 311.
  • Estuaries, how formed, 327, 337.
  • ——, imbedding of freshwater species in, 768.
  • Etna, description of and its eruptions, 396 to 424.
  • ——, towns overflowed by lava of, 400, 728.
  • ——, subterranean caverns on, 401.
  • ——, a glacier under lava on, 412.
  • ——, marine formations at its base, 401.
  • ——, antiquity of cone of, 422.
  • Euganean Hills, lavas of, 359.
  • Euphrates, delta of advancing rapidly, 284.
  • Euxine burst its barrier, according to Strabo, 14.
  • ——, gradually filling up, 14.
  • ——. See Black Sea.
  • Evaporation, water carried off by, 260, 294, 334.
  • ——, currents caused by, 294.
  • Everest, Rev. E., on climate of fossil elephant, 81.
  • ——, on sediment of Ganges, 282.
  • Excavation of valleys, 488.
  • Expansion of rocks by heat, 560.
  • Extinction of species, 697, 701.
  • ——, of animals, 700, 702.

F.

F.

  • Fabio Colonna, 23.
  • Facial angle, 608.
  • Fair Island, action of the sea on, 301.
  • Falconer, Dr., on fossil quadrumana, 144.
  • ——, on crocodiles of Ganges, 277.
  • 823Falconer, Dr., on peat near Calcutta, 280.
  • Falconi on elevation of coast of Baiæ, 367.
  • Falkland Islands, quadrupeds of, 141, 635.
  • Falloppio on fossils, 21.
  • Falls of Niagara, 214.
  • ——, of St. Mary, 254.
  • Faluns of Touraine, 142.
  • Faraday, Mr., on water of the Geysers, 246.
  • ——, on slow deposition of sulphate of baryta, 343.
  • ——, on electric currents In the earth, 543.
  • ——, on metallic reduction by voltaic agency, 548.
  • ——, on liquefaction of gases, 560.
  • Faroe Islands, deposits forming near the, 774.
  • Farquharson, Rev. J., on floods in Scotland, 208.
  • ——, on formation of ground ice, 222.
  • Faujas, on Velay and Vivarais, 1779, 49.
  • Faults, 162.
  • Fauna formerly as diversified as now, 160.
  • ——, arctic, described by Sir J. Richardson, 634
  • Felspar, decomposition of, 247.
  • Ferrara on lavas of Etna, 283.
  • ——, on floods on Etna, 412.
  • ——, on earthquake in Sicily, 471.
  • Ferruginous springs, 247.
  • Fez, earthquakes in, 358.
  • Fife, trap rocks of, 160.
  • ——, coast of, submarine forests on, 303.
  • ——, encroachments of sea on, 203.
  • Findhorn town swept away by sea, 302.
  • Fish, their distribution, and migrations, 646.
  • ——, fossil, 745.
  • ——, fossil of coal formation, 136.
  • Fissures, sulphur, &c., ejected by, 470.
  • ——, caused by Calabrian earthquake, 479, 480, 481.
  • ——, caused by earthquake near New Madrid, 468.
  • ——, preservation of organic remains in, 732.
  • Fitton, Dr., on history of English geology, 51.
  • Fitzroy, Capt., on earthquake in Chili, 1835, 453, 455.
  • Flamborough Head, waste of, 303.
  • Fleming, Dr., on uniformity in climate, 74.
  • ——, on fossil elephant, 76.
  • ——, on submarine forests, 303.
  • ——, on rapid flight of birds, 646.
  • ——, on turtles taken on coast of England, 645.
  • ——, on changes in the animal kingdom caused by man, 683.
  • ——, on stranding of cetacea, 771.
  • Flinders on coral reefs, 776, 791.
  • Flint on course of Mississippi, &c., 264, 265.
  • ——, on earthquakes in Mississippi valley, 466.
  • Floods, by bursting of lakes, 269.
  • ——, in North America, 209.
  • ——, in valley of Bagnes, 210.
  • ——, in Scotland, 207, 750.
  • ——, traditions of, 499, 501.
  • ——, causes which may give rise to, 156.
  • ——, at Tivoli, 211.
  • ——, caused by melting of snow by lava, 348, 411.
  • ——. See Deluge.
  • Flysch, of the Alps, eocene, 124.
  • Folkstone, subsidence of land at, 316.
  • Fontenelle, his eulogy on Palissy, 23.
  • Foot-marks, fossil, in North America, 136.
  • Forbes, Prof. E., on glacial epoch, 86.
  • ——, on fossils of tertiary, 184.
  • ——, on new island in Gulf of Santorin, 443.
  • ——, on regions of depth in Ægean Sea, 649.
  • ——, on migration of mollusca, 651.
  • ——, cited, 703.
  • Forbes, Prof. J. D., on glacier motion, 224.
  • ——, on rate of flowing of lava, 378, 400.
  • ——, on temple of Serapis, 515, 517.
  • Forchhammer, Dr., on boulders drifted by ice, 231.
  • ——, on peat, 719.
  • Forests, influence of, 712, 713, 715.
  • ——, sites of, now covered by peat, 720.
  • ——, destroyed by insects, 717.
  • ——, submarine, 303, 323, 746.
  • Forests, submerged. In Colombia R. by landslides, 215.
  • Forfarshire, waste of coast of, 302.
  • ——, marl lakes of, 766, 796.
  • Forshey, Mr., on Mississippi, 264, 271.
  • Forster, Mr., on coral reefs, 778.
  • Forsyth on climate of Italy, 395.
  • Fortis cited, 42.
  • ——, views of Arduino confirmed by, 48.
  • ——, and Testa on fossil fish, 44.
  • Fort William, near Calcutta, artesian well, 280.
  • Fossiliferous formations, breaks in the series, 180.
  • Fossilization of organic remains on emerged land, 718, 775.
  • ——, in peat mosses, 722.
  • ——, In caves and fissures, 732.
  • ——, in alluvium and landslips, 730.
  • ——, in volcanic formations on land, 349, 728.
  • ——, in subaqueous deposits, 742, 753.
  • ——, in marl lakes, 752.
  • Fossils, early speculations concerning their nature, 19, 24 to 27.
  • ——, distinctness of secondary and tertiary, 119.
  • ——, mammiferous of tertiary eras, 137, 140.
  • ——, why distinct in successive groups, 190.
  • ——, See Organic Remains.
  • Fossil trees, upright position of some, 91.
  • Fourier, Baron, on temperature of spaces surrounding our atmosphere, 108.
  • ——, on central heat, 127.
  • ——, on radiation of heat, 127.
  • Fox, Mr., on heat in mines, 538.
  • ——, on electric currents in the earth, 543.
  • France, waste of coast of, 324.
  • ——, caves of, 737.
  • Franconia, caves of, 736.
  • Franklin, on a whirlwind in Maryland, 619.
  • Fremont, Capt., on submerged forests in Columbia, 270.
  • Freshwater plants and animals fossilized, 766, 768.
  • ——, strata in Cashmere, 762.
  • Freyberg, school at, 46, 52.
  • Fries, on dispersion of cryptogamic plants, 620.
  • Fringing reef, nature and origin of, 785.
  • ——, upraised, 794.
  • Fuchsel, opinions of, 1762, 43.
  • Funchal. rise of sea at, during earthquake, 496.
  • Fundy, Bay of, wave called the "bore" in, 332.

G.

G.

  • Gaillonella ferruginea, 722.
  • Galapagos, peculiar character of the fauna of 139, 635, 643.
  • ——, island, tameness of birds in, 597.
  • ——, Archipelago, craters form hills in, 372.
  • Galongoon, great eruption of, 353, 430.
  • Gambier coral island, 783, 787.
  • Ganges, delta of, and Brahmapootra, 275 to 284.
  • ——, antiquity of delta of, 281.
  • ——, quantity of sediment in waters of, 278.
  • ——, islands formed by the, 276.
  • ——, bones of men found in delta of. 757.
  • ——, artesian borings in delta of, 268.
  • Gardner, Mr., on unexplored Antarctic land, 99.
  • Gases, liquefaction of, 560.
  • ——, evolved by volcanoes, 549.
  • Gefle, upraised shelly deposits near, 526, 528.
  • Gemmellaro on Etna, 408.
  • ——, on ice under lava, 412.
  • Generation, spontaneous, theory of, 22.
  • Generelli. on state of geology in Europe in middle of eighteenth century, 35, 53.
  • Geneva, lake of, delta of Rhone in, 252.
  • Geognosy of Werner, 46.
  • Geographical distribution of plants, 613.
  • ——, of animals, 629.
  • ——, of birds, 642.
  • ——, of reptiles, 644.
  • ——, of fishes, 646.
  • ——, of testacea. 649.
  • ——, of zoophytes, 653.
  • 824 Geographical distribution of insects, 654.
  • ——, of man, 659.
  • Geography, proofs of former changes in physical, 114, 121.
  • ——, effect of changes in, on species, 690.
  • Geological society of London, 59.
  • ——, theories, causes of error in, 61.
  • Geology defined, 1.
  • ——, distinct from cosmogony, 3.
  • ——, causes of its retardation, 24, 55, 61.
  • ——, state of, before eighteenth century, 86.
  • ——, modern progress of, 58.
  • Georgia, Island of, snow to level of sea in, 99, 108.
  • ——, U. S., new ravines formed in, 205.
  • Gerbanites, an Arabian sect, their doctrines, 14.
  • German Ocean, filling up, 340.
  • Gesner, John, on organic remains, 41.
  • Geysers of Iceland, 533, 553.
  • ——, cause of their intermittent action, 555.
  • Gibraltar, birds' bones in breccia at, 740.
  • ——, Straits of, 383.
  • Gironde, tides in its estuary, 338.
  • Glacial epoch, 75.
  • Glacier under lava, on Etna, 412.
  • ——, moraines of, 223.
  • ——, view of, 223.
  • Glaciers, formation of, 222 to 227.
  • ——, motion of, 228.
  • ——, of Spitzbergen, 96.
  • ——, transportation of rocks by, 155.
  • Glen Tilt, granite veins of, 51.
  • Gloucestershire, gain of land in, 324.
  • Gmelin on distribution of fish, 648.
  • Goats, multiplication of, in South America, 686.
  • Goeppert, Prof., 87.
  • ——, on fossilization of plants, 747.
  • Golden age, doctrine whence derived, 9.
  • Goodwin Sands, 314.
  • Gothenburg, rise of land near, 526.
  • Graab, Capt., on subsidence of Greenland, 530.
  • Graham, Mrs., on earthquake of Chili in 1822, 459.
  • Graham Island, newly formed in 1831, 432.
  • ——, supposed section of, 435.
  • Granite of the Hartz, Werner on, 47.
  • ——, disintegration of, 221, 346.
  • ——, formed at different periods, 177.
  • ——, veins observed by Hutton in Glen Tilt, 51.
  • Grant, Capt., on Chilian earthquake, 462.
  • Graves, Capt., on diffusion of insects by winds, 656.
  • ——, survey of Santorin by, 441.
  • Gray, Mr., on Mytilus polymorphus, 658.
  • Great Dismal Swamp, Virginia, 724.
  • Grecian Archipelago, new isles of the, 43.
  • ——, volcanoes of the, 355, 442, 450.
  • Greece, earthquakes in, 355.
  • ——, traditions of deluges in, 356.
  • Greeks, geology of, 13.
  • Greenland, why colder than Lapland, 94.
  • ——, gradual subsidence of, 530, 562.
  • ——, timber drifted to shores of, 745.
  • Grevllle, Dr., on drift sea-weed, 623.
  • Groins described, 818.
  • Grooves in rocks formed by glaciers, 155, 227, 228.
  • Grotto del Cane, 248.
  • Ground ice, 221.
  • ——, transporting rocks in Baltic, 231.
  • Guadalonpe, human skeletons of 757.
  • Guatemala, active volcanoes in, 349.
  • Gulana, partly formed by sediment of Amazon, 342.
  • Guilding, Rev. L., on migration of Boa Constrictor, 646.
  • Guinea current, 296.
  • Guinea, New, mammalia of, 682.
  • Gulf stream, 96, 292, 294. 621.
  • ——, stream aids migration of fish, 648.
  • Guyot, M., on glacier motion, 224.
  • Gyrogonite described, 766.

H.

H.

  • Habitations of plants described, 614.
  • Hales, Dr., on epoch of the creation, 659.
  • Hall, Sir J., his experiments on rocks, 51.
  • ——, Captain B., on flood in valley of Bagnes, 211.
  • ——, on the trade-winds, 295.
  • ——, on temple of Serapis, 512.
  • ——, Mr., State Geologist of New York, 216, 218.
  • ——, Mr. J., on temple of Serapis, 512.
  • Hamilton, Mr. W. J., on volcanoes near Smyrna, 355.
  • ——, Sir W., on Herculaneum, 389.
  • ——, on earthquake in Calabria, 473, 483, 485.
  • ——, Sir W., on formation of Monte Nuovo, 367.
  • ——, on eruption of Vesuvius in 1779, 377.
  • Hamilton, Sir C., on submerged houses in Port Royal, 504.
  • Hampshire, Brander on fossils of, 44.
  • ——, submarine forest on coast of, 746.
  • Harcourt, Rev. W. V. V., on bones of mammoth, &c., in Yorkshire, 76.
  • Harris, Hon. C., on sunk vessel near Poole, 758.
  • ——, on submarine forest, Hampshire, 746.
  • Hartmann, Dr., on fossils of Hartz, 48.
  • Hartz mountains, 48.
  • Harwich, waste of cliffs at, 811.
  • Hatfleld moss, trees found in, 721.
  • Head, Sir Edmund, on temple of Serapis, 512.
  • Heat, laws which govern the diffusion of, 93.
  • Heat, whether gradual decline of, in globe, 129.
  • ——, expansion of rocks by, 561.
  • Heber, Bishop, on animals of Himalaya, 81.
  • Hecla, columnar basalt of, 48.
  • ——, eruptions of, 424.
  • Helena, St, bounded by lofty shores, 622.
  • Heligoland, inroads of sea on, 329.
  • Helix, range of species of, 650.
  • Henderson on eruption of Skaptar Jokul, 1783, 425.
  • Henderson's Island described, 788.
  • Henslow, Rev. Prof., on the cowslip, 590.
  • ——, on diffusion of plants, 624.
  • Herbert, Hon. Mr., on varieties and hybrids in plants, 590, 605.
  • Herculaneum, 385, 389.
  • Herne Bay, waste of cliffs in, 312.
  • Herodotus cited, 8, 261.
  • Herschel, Sir J. F. W, on varying heat received
  • by the two hemispheres, 100.
  • ——, on astronomical causes of changes in climate, 126.
  • ——, on variable splendor of stars, 128.
  • ——, on the trade-winds, 297.
  • ——, on height of Etna, 396.
  • ——, on form of the earth, 534.
  • ——, on Geysers of Iceland, 555.
  • ——, on the effects of heat on seeds, 621.
  • ——, on the author's theory of climate, 92.
  • Herschel, Sir W., on the elementary matter of the earth, 533.
  • Hewett, Capt, on rise of tides, 291.
  • ——, on currents, 293.
  • ——, on banks in North Sea, 308, 340.
  • Hibbert, Dr., on the Shetland Islands, 299, 300.
  • Hilaire, M. Geof. St., on animal kingdom, 567.
  • Himalaya mountains, animals inhabiting the, 81.
  • ——, height of perpetual snow on, 112.
  • Hindoo cosmogony, 4.
  • ——, town buried, 731.
  • Hindostan, earthquakes in, 494.
  • Hippopotamus indicates warmth of river, 75.
  • Hitchcock, Report on Geol. of Massachusetts, 137.
  • Hoff, Von, on level of Caspian, 18.
  • ——, on encroachments of sea, 331, 332.
  • ——, on earthquakes, 359.
  • ——, on human remains in delta of Ganges, 757.
  • ——, on a buried vessel, 758.
  • Hoffmann, M., on lavas of Vesuvius, 379.
  • ——, on Etna, 415, 416.
  • 825 Holland, gradual sinking of coast, 327.
  • ——, inroads of sea in, 328.
  • ——, submarine peat in, 770.
  • Hooke on duration of species, 27, 28.
  • ——, on earthquakes, 27, 29, 503.
  • Hooker, Dr. J., on Icebergs in antarctic seas, 229.
  • ——, on tropical plants, 614.
  • ——, floras of islands in Southern Ocean, 615.
  • ——, on flora of Galapagos Islands, 616.
  • ——, on wide range of certain plants, 618, 621, 623.
  • ——, on delta of Ganges, 280.
  • ——, on rain in India, 200.
  • Hocker, Sir W., on eruption of Skaptar Jokul, 425.
  • ——, his view of the crater of the great Geyser, 554.
  • ——, on drifting of a fox on ice, 680.
  • Hopkins, Mr., on glacier motion, 224, 225.
  • ——, on thickness of earth's crust, 536.
  • Hopkins, Mr., on astronomical causes of change of climate, 128.
  • ——, on changes of climate, 93.
  • ——, on earthquakes, 453.
  • ——, on M. E. de Beaumont's theory of mountain chains, 170.
  • Hordwell, loss of land at, 318.
  • Horner, Mr., on brine springs, 247.
  • ——, on submarine forest in Somersetshire, 323.
  • ——, dissertation on coal, 91.
  • Horsburgh, Capt, on icebergs in low latitudes, 99.
  • Horsburgh on coral islands, 782, 787.
  • Horses drowned in rivers in South America, 750.
  • Horsfield, Dr., on earthquakes in Java, 471, 494.
  • ——, on distribution of Mydaus meliceps in Java, 639.
  • Hubbard, Prof., cited, 210.
  • Huc, on Yaks frozen in ice in Thibet, 85.
  • Human race geologically modern, 660.
  • Human remains in peat mosses, 722.
  • ——, in caves, 735, 736, 739.
  • ——, their durability, 147, 757.
  • ——, in delta of Ganges, 757.
  • ——, in calcareous rock at Guadaloupe, 757.
  • ——, in breccias in the Morea, 735.
  • Humber, warp of the, 288.
  • ——, encroachment of sea in its estuary, 304
  • Humboldt on laws regulating diffusion of heat, 93.
  • ——, on preservation of animals in frozen mud, 85.
  • ——, on distribution of land and sea, 109.
  • ——, on transportation of sediment by currents, 342.
  • ——, his definition of volcanic action, 345.
  • ——, on mud eruptions in the Andes, 348.
  • ——, on volcanic eruptions in Tartary, 355.
  • ——, on eruption of Jorullo, 428.
  • ——, on earthquakes, 466, 470.
  • ——, on distribution of species, 613, 614.
  • ——, on migrations of animals, 644, 656, 685.
  • ——, cited, 8, 77, 84.
  • ——, on earthquake in New Madrid, 466.
  • ——, on earthquake of Lisbon, 495.
  • ——, on mud volcanoes, 448.
  • Humboldt, W. von, on dawn of oriental civilization, 659.
  • Humming-birds, distribution, &c., 97, 643.
  • Hunter, John, on mule animals, 601.
  • Huron, Lake, recent strata of, 768.
  • Hurricanes connected with earthquakes, 731.
  • ——, plants drifted to sea by, 745.
  • Hurst Castle shingle bank, 318.
  • Hutchinson, John, his "Moses's Principia," 33.
  • Hutton, distinguished geology from cosmogony, 3.
  • ——, on igneous rocks and granite, 51.
  • ——, represented oldest rock as derivatives, 52.
  • Huttonian theory, 51, 57.
  • Hybrid races, Lamarck on, 572.
  • ——, animals, 600.
  • ——, plants, 602.
  • Hydrogen, deoxidating power of, 547.
  • ——, flame of; seen in eruption of Vesuvius, 378.
  • ——, why not found in a separate form among volcanic gases, 548.
  • Hydrophytes, distribution of, 617, 623.
  • Hydrostatic pressure of ascending lava, 416, 553.
  • Hypogene rocks, 178.
  • Hyracotherium, Eocene mammifer, 142.
  • Hythe, encroachments of sea at, 316.

I.

I.

  • Ianthina fragilis, its range, &c., 650.
  • Ice, animals imbedded in, 83.
  • Ice of rivers, transporting power of, 219.
  • ——, drift, influence of, on temperature, 95.
  • ——, predominance of, in antarctic circle, 98.
  • ——, formation of field, 107.
  • ——, transportation of rocks by, 155, 219, 521.
  • Icebergs, formation of, 96, 97.
  • ——, distance to which they float, 100, 227.
  • ——, limits of glaciers and, 228.
  • ——, plants and animals transported by, 622, 639.
  • ——, action of, when stranded, 228.
  • ——, rocks transported by. See Ice.
  • ——, floating in Northern hemisphere, 86.
  • ——, not all formed by glaciers, 228.
  • Iceland, icebergs stranded on, 97.
  • ——, geysers of, 246, 553, 555.
  • Iceland, volcanic eruptions in, 424.
  • ——, comparison between the lavas of Central France and, 426.
  • ——, new island near, 425.
  • ——, polar bear drifted to, 679.
  • Igneous action. See Volcanic.
  • Igneous causes. See Book II.
  • ——, the antagonist power to action of running water, 198, 563, 711.
  • Ilford, tertiary strata at, 76.
  • Imbedding of organic remains. See Fossilization.
  • India, buried cities in, 729, 731.
  • ——, terrestrial mammalia of, 632.
  • Indo-pacific province of mollusca, 649.
  • Indus, delta of. recent changes in, 459, 769.
  • ——, buried ships in, 758.
  • Infusoria in bog iron-ore, 722.
  • ——, in volcanic rocks in Mexico, Peru, &c., 388.
  • Infusorial tuff, Pompeii, 388.
  • Inland cliffs, no proof of sudden elevation, 531.
  • ——, seas, deltas of, 255.
  • Insects, geographical distribution of, 654.
  • ——, certain types of, distinguish particular countries, 655.
  • ——, their agency in preserving an equilibrium of species, 671.
  • ——, fossil, 748.
  • Instincts, migratory, occasional development of, in animals, 642.
  • ——, hereditary, 593, 596.
  • ——, modified by domestication, 595.
  • Insular climates, description of, 94.
  • Inverness-shire, inroads of sea on coast of, 302.
  • Irawadi, R., silicified wood of, noticed in 1692, 28.
  • Ireland, raised beaches on coast of, 122.
  • ——, reptiles of, 645.
  • ——, peat of, and fossils in, 719, 720, 724
  • ——, deposits in progress off coast of, 774.
  • Iron, melting point of, 539.
  • ——, in wood, peat, &c., 722.
  • ——, instruments taken up from sea, 760.
  • Ischia, hot springs of, 247, 456.
  • ——, eruptions and earthquakes in, 360, 365, 456.
  • Islands, vegetation of small, 112, 615, 667.
  • ——, animals in, 635.
  • ——, formed by the Ganges, 276.
  • ——, migrations of plants aided by, 622.
  • ——, new volcanic, 43, 425, 432, 468.
  • ——, coral, 775.
  • ——, of driftwood, 640.
  • Isle of Purbeck, vertical chalk in, 318.
  • Isle of Wight, mammiferous fossils of, 142.
  • ——, waste of its shores, 317.
  • Isothermal lines, Humboldt on, 95.
  • 826 Italian geologists, their priority, 19, 23.
  • ——, of the 18th century, 33.
  • Italy, tertiary strata of, 64, 74.

J.

J.

  • Jack, Dr., on island of Pulo Nias, 794.
  • Jamaica, earthquakes in, 350, 504, 517.
  • ——, subsidence in, 504, 517.
  • ——, rain diminished in, by felling of forests, 713.
  • ——, a town swept away by sea in, 731.
  • Java, volcanoes and earthquakes in, 354, 464, 498, 502.
  • ——, valley of poison in, 353.
  • ——, subsidence of volcano of Papandayang in, 493.
  • ——, river-floods in, 503, 748, 751.
  • Jones, Sir W., on Institutes of Hindoo law, 5.
  • Jorullo, eruption of, 349, 428.
  • Juan Fernandez, 357, 453, 499, 686.
  • Jukes, Mr., on cliffs in Island of Timor, 794.
  • ——, on volcanic islands near Java, 354.
  • ——, on coral reef, 784.
  • Jura, Saussure on the, 45.
  • Jutland, inroads of sea in, 330.

K.

K.

  • Kamtschatka, volcanoes in, 353.
  • ——, new island near, 468.
  • Kangaroo, extirpation of; to Australia, 684.
  • Kashmir. See Cashmere.
  • Katavothrons of Greece, breccias formed in, 734.
  • Kazwini on changes in position of land and sea, 19.
  • Keilhan, Prof., of Christiana, on changes of level in Norway, 529, 531.
  • Keith on dispersion of plants, 620.
  • Kent, loss of land on coast of, 312.
  • Kentucky, caves in limestone, 733.
  • Keyserling, Count, on lowland of Siberia, 84.
  • Kincardineshire, village in, washed away by sea, 302.
  • King, Captain P., on humming birds in Tierra del Fuego, 97, 643.
  • ——, on currents in Straits of Magellan, 293.
  • ——, on coral reefs, 788.
  • King, Mr., on cattle lost in bogs in Ireland, 723.
  • ——, on submerged cannon, 759.
  • Kinnordy, Loch of, insects in marl in, 748.
  • ——, canoe in peat of, 759.
  • Kirby, Rev. Mr., on insects, 606, 655, 673, 674.
  • Kirwan, his geological Essays, 56.
  • ——, on connection of geology and religion, 56.
  • Knight, Mr., on varieties of fruit trees, 589.
  • König, Mr., on Guadaloupe human skeleton, 757.
  • ——, on fossils from Melville Island, 88.
  • Koran, cosmogony of the, 17.
  • Kotzebue on drifted canoe, 662.
  • Kunker, concretionary limestone of Ganges, 280.
  • Kurile Isles, active volcanoes in, 353.

L.

L.

  • Labrador, drift-timber of, 745.
  • ——, rocks drifted by ice on coast of, 230.
  • Laccadive Islands, 782.
  • Lagoons, or salt lakes, in delta of Rhone, 259.
  • ——, of coral islands, 780.
  • Lagullas current, 95.
  • Lagunes on coast of Adriatic, 256.
  • Lake Erie. See Erie, Lake.
  • ——, of Geneva. See Geneva, Lake of.
  • ——, Maeler, 524, 528.
  • ——, Superior. See Superior, Lake.
  • Lakes, filling up of 252.
  • ——, formation of; in basin of Mississippi, 466, 269.
  • ——, formed by earthquakes, 466, 481, 505.
  • ——, crescent-shaped, in plain of Mississippi, 266.
  • ——, Canadian, strata forming in, 768.
  • Lamarck, his definition of species, 567.
  • ——, on transmutation of species, 567, 587, 696, 699.
  • ——, on conversion of orang into man, 575.
  • ——, on numbers of polyps, 706.
  • Lancashire, fossil canoes in, 759.
  • Lancerote, eruptions in, 436, 439.
  • Land, quantity of, in northern and southern hemispheres, 102, 109, 110.
  • ——, upraised at successive periods, 118, 119.
  • ——, proofs of existence of, at all periods, 188.
  • ——, proportion of sea and, 124.
  • ——, elevation of, how caused, 171, 453, 457, 459, 562.
  • Landslips, 319, 321, 485, 505.
  • ——, imbedding of organic remains by, 732.
  • Languedoc, deposits on coast of, 260.
  • Laplace on change in the earth's axis, 32.
  • ——, on mean depth of Atlantic and Pacific, 104.
  • ——, on no contraction of globe, 129.
  • ——, on mean density of the earth, 536.
  • Lapland, why milder than Greenland, 94.
  • ——, migrations of animals in, 637.
  • Lateral pressure caused by landslips, 322.
  • ——, pressure in Andes and Alps, 171.
  • Latham, Dr. R. G., on Natural History of Man, 609.
  • Lauder, Sir T. D., on floods in Scotland, 208, 686, 730, 748.
  • Lava excavated by rivers, 213.
  • ——, effects of decomposition on, 385.
  • ——, flowing of, under water, 383.
  • ——, hydrostatic pressure of ascending, 552.
  • ——, of Iceland and Central France, 426, 427.
  • ——, comparative volume of ancient and modern, 161, 427.
  • ——, pretended distinction between ancient and modern, 438.
  • ——, mineral composition of, 449, 551.
  • ——, rate of flowing, 378, 400.
  • Lazzaro Moro, See Moro.
  • Lehman, treatise of, 1759, 40.
  • Leibnitz, theory of, 26.
  • Leidy, Dr., on Priscodelphinus, 145.
  • Lemings, migrations of, 637.
  • Lena, R., fossil bones on banks of, 78, 80.
  • Leonardo da Vinci, 19.
  • Lewes, human bones in tumulus near, 739.
  • ——, estuary recently filled up near, 748, 768.
  • Liege, caves near, 737.
  • Light, influence of, on plants, 89.
  • Lightning, effect of, in Shetland Islands, 299.
  • Lignite, conversion of wood into, 759.
  • Lima destroyed by earthquake, 501.
  • ——, elevated recent marine strata at, 502.
  • Lime, whence derived, 796.
  • Lincolnshire, inroads of sea on coast of, 304.
  • Lindley, Dr., on fossil plants of Melville Islands, 88.
  • ——, on number of plants, 705.
  • ——, on dispersion of plants, 620.
  • ——, on fossil plants of coal, 88, 133.
  • ——, cited, 133.
  • Linnæus on filling up of Gulf of Bothnia, 521.
  • ——, on subsidence of Scania, 530.
  • ——, on constancy of species, 568.
  • ——, on real existence of genera, 578.
  • ——, on diffusion of plants, 624, 626.
  • ——, on introduction of species, 665.
  • ——, cited, 671.
  • Lionnesse tradition in Cornwall, 324.
  • Lippi on Herculaneum and Pompeii, 387.
  • Lipsius, 12.
  • Lisbon, earthquakes at, 358, 495.
  • Lister, first proposed geological maps, 26.
  • ——, on fossil shells, 26.
  • Lloyd, Mr., on levels of Atlantic and Pacific, 294.
  • Loa, Mount, volcano of Sandwich Isles, 552.
  • Locusts, devastations of, 674.
  • ——, bank formed in sea by, 675.
  • Loess of the Rhine, 185.
  • ——, of the Mississippi valley, 265.
  • Loire, tertiary strata of the, 142.
  • 827

    London, artesian wells near, 234.
  • London basin, tertiary deposits of, 121.
  • ——, clay, its fossils, 142, 144.
  • Lowestoff Ness described, 309.
  • ——, cliffs undermined near, 309.
  • Lowland of Siberia, 78, 80, 83, 85.
  • Luckipour, on the Ganges, 276, 277.
  • ——, new islands formed near, 276.
  • Luckput, subsidence near, 460.
  • Lund, Dr., on fossil quadrumana, 144.
  • Lybian sands, caravans overwhelmed by, 727.
  • Lyme Regis, waste of cliffs at, 321.
  • Lym-Fiord, breaches made by the sea in, 330.

M.

M.

  • MacClelland, Dr., on earthquakes In Chittagong, 494.
  • ——, on volcanic line In Bay of Bengal, 354.
  • MacCulloch, Dr., on gradation from peat to coal, 719.
  • ——, on origin of limestones, 796.
  • Macacus pliocenus of Owen, fossil in valley of Thames, 144.
  • ——, Suffolk Eocene species, 144.
  • Macaluba, in Sicily, mud volcanoes, 447.
  • Mackenzie, Sir G., his section of geyser, 556.
  • ——, on reindeer in Iceland, 686.
  • Mackenzie River, driftwood of, 90, 743.
  • ——, floods of, 84.
  • Maclaren, Mr. C., on Graham Island, 435.
  • ——, on quantity of useful soil in America, 687.
  • ——, on position of American forests, 714
  • ——, remarks, theory of atolls, 792.
  • Macmurdo, Captain, on earthquake of Cutch, 460.
  • Madagascar, extent of coral near, 776.
  • ——, assemblage of quadrupeds in, 632.
  • Madrid, New, great earthquake at, 466.
  • ——, sunk country near it, 270.
  • Maeler, lake, 524, 528.
  • Magellan, Straits of, tides in, 291, 293.
  • Magnesia deposited by springs, 283.
  • Magnesian limestone and travertin compared, 240.
  • Magnetism, terrestrial, phenomena of, 543.
  • ——, solar, 129.
  • Mahomet, his cosmogony, 18.
  • Malabar, coral near, 776.
  • Maldive Islands, coral reefs of, 778, 782.
  • Mallet, Captain, on petroleum of Trinidad, 250.
  • Mallet, Mr., on the dynamics of earthquakes, 453, 475.
  • ——, on whirling motion during earthquakes, 476.
  • ——, cited, 560.
  • ——, on transit of the earth-wave, 483.
  • ——, on theory of waves, 498.
  • Mammalia, different regions of indigenous, 629.
  • ——, fossil, of successive tertiary periods. 138, 139.
  • ——, imbedding of, in subaqueous strata, 749, 753.
  • Mammifer, fossil of trias, 137.
  • Mammoth, Siberian, 75.
  • ——, bones of, in Yorkshire, 76.
  • Man, recent origin of, 147, 182, 687, 764.
  • ——, why able to live in all climates, 609.
  • ——, diffusion of, 657.
  • ——, changes caused by, 150, 182, 630, 663, 681, 713.
  • ——, durability of the bones of, 147, 757.
  • ——, remains of, in osseous breccias of Morea, 735.
  • ——, his remains and works fossil, 753.
  • Manetho, 63.
  • Mantell, Dr., on bones from Saxon tumulus, 788.
  • ——, on Lewes levels, 748, 768.
  • Map of Siberia, 79.
  • ——, of World, showing present unequal distribution of land and sea, 110.
  • ——, showing position of land and sea, which might produce extremes of heat and cold, 111.
  • ——, of Europe, showing extent of land covered by sea since commencement of tertiary period (Pl. I.), 121.
  • Map of coast from Nieuport to mouth of Elbe, 326.
  • ——, of volcanoes from Philippine Islands to Bengal, 351.
  • ——, of volcanic district of Naples, 361.
  • ——, of Gulf of Santorin, 442.
  • ——, of Chili, 454, 455.
  • ——, of Cutch, 460.
  • ——, of Calabria, 472.
  • ——, of Sweden, 522.
  • Maracaybo, Lake, 466.
  • Marine deposits, imbedding of land quadrupeds in, 749, 752.
  • ——, of human remains and works of art in, 756.
  • ——, of freshwater species in, 768.
  • ——, plants and animals imbedded in, 770.
  • Marine vegetation. 617, 622.
  • Marl lakes of Scotland, animals and plants fossilized in, 752, 766.
  • Marsili, on arrangement of shells in Adriatic, 36, 38, 40.
  • ——, on deposits of coasts of Languedoc, 260.
  • Marsupial animals, distribution of, 633.
  • ——, fossil, 138.
  • Martigny destroyed by floods, 211.
  • Martius, on drifting of animals by the Amazon, 641.
  • ——, on Brazil, 682.
  • Maryland, whirlwind in, 619.
  • Mattani on fossils of Volterra, 34.
  • Mattioli on organic remains, 21.
  • Mauritius, reef uplifted above level of sea, 794.
  • Mediterranean, microscopic testacea of, 44.
  • ——, deposition of salt in the, 334.
  • ——, new island in, 432.
  • ——, its temperature, depth, level, &c., 45, 294, 334, 510.
  • ——, same level as Red Sea, 294
  • Megna, R., arm of Brahmapootra, 279.
  • Melville Island, fossils of, 90.
  • ——, migrations of animals into, 640.
  • Melville, Dr., on dodo, 684.
  • Memphis, in delta of Nile, 261.
  • Mendip Hills, caves of, 737.
  • Menu's Institutes, 4, 5.
  • Mercati on organic remains, 22.
  • Mersey, vessel in bed of, 758.
  • Messina, tide in Straits of, 290.
  • ——, earthquakes at, 477, 488, 490.
  • Metallic nucleus, theory of an unoxidated, 545.
  • Metallic substances changed by submersion, 759.
  • Metamorphic rocks, how formed, 177.
  • ——, of the Alps, 178.
  • ——, why those visible to us must be very ancient, 178.
  • Mexico, Gulf of, tides in, 295.
  • ——, currents in, 96, 292.
  • ——, volcanoes of, 349, 546.
  • Meyen, Dr., on earthquake in Chili, 1822, 458.
  • Michell on phenomena of earthquakes, 41.
  • ——, on the geology of Yorkshire, 42.
  • ——, on earthquake at Lisbon, 358, 497.
  • ——, on retreat of the sea during earthquakes, 498.
  • ——, on wave-like motion of earthquakes, 558.
  • ——, on earthquakes cited, 499.
  • Microlestes, triassic mammifer, 138, 145.
  • Middendorf, Mr., on Siberian mammoth, 81.
  • Migrations of plants, 618.
  • ——, of animals, 635, 636.
  • ——, of cetacea, 642.
  • ——, of birds, 642.
  • ——, of fish, 646.
  • ——, of zoophytes, 653.
  • ——, of insects, 655.
  • Migratory powers indispensable to animals, 689.
  • Milford Haven, rise of tides at, 291.
  • Millennium, 20, 32.
  • Mineral waters, their connection with volcanoes, 237.
  • ——, ingredients most common in. See Springs, 237.
  • Mineralization of plants, 747.
  • 828 Mines, heat in, augments with the depth, 538.
  • Miocene strata of Suffolk, fossils of, 142.
  • ——, proportion of living species in fossil shells of the, 183.
  • Mississippi, its course, delta, &c., 268, 275.
  • ——, drift-wood of the, 261.
  • ——, earthquakes in valley of, 270, 350.
  • ——, antiquity of delta of, 272.
  • ——, earthquake region of, 467.
  • ——, banks higher than swamps, 266.
  • Missouri, R., 264.
  • Mitchell, Dr., on waste of cliffs, 311.
  • Moel Tryfane, recent marine shells on, 122.
  • Mollusca. See Testacea.
  • ——, provinces of, 649.
  • Molluscous animals, longevity of species of, 76.
  • Moluccas, eruptions in the, 504.
  • Monkeys, fossil, 144.
  • Monte Barbaro, description of, 373.
  • ——, Bolca, fossil fish of, 44
  • ——, Nuovo, formation of, 369, 518.
  • ——, Somma, structure of, 382.
  • Monti Rossi on Etna described, 397, 399, 422.
  • Montlosier, on Auvergne, 49.
  • Moraines of glaciers, 223, 226, 228.
  • Morayshire, town in, destroyed by sea, 302.
  • ——, effect of floods in, 208, 730.
  • Morea, Céramiqne of, 731.
  • ——, osseous breccias now forming in the, 734.
  • ——, human remains imbedded in, 735.
  • Moriot, on subsidence in Adriatic, 257.
  • Moro, Lazzaro, his geological views, 34.
  • ——, on primary rocks, 52.
  • Morocco, earthquakes at, 358.
  • Morton, Dr. S. G., on hybrids and species, 601.
  • Mountain chains, on the elevation of, 65.
  • ——, theory of sudden rise of, 163.
  • Moya of the Andes described, 348, 470.
  • Mud eruptions in Quito, 1797, 348.
  • ——, volcanoes, 447.
  • Mules sometimes prolific, 601.
  • Murchison, Sir R., on the Hartz mountains, 48.
  • ——, on tertiary deposits of the Alps, 119.
  • ——, on geography of Siberia, 78, 84, 124.
  • ——, map of Russia, 123.
  • ——, on depression of Caspian, 157.
  • ——, on travertin of Tivoli, 245.
  • ——, on tertiary deposits of Alps, 124.
  • Muschelkalk, 193.
  • Mydaus meliceps, 639.
  • Myrmecobius, fasciatus, 138.
  • Mytilus polymorphus, 652.

N.

N.

  • Nantucket, banks of, 293.
  • Naples, volcanic district round, 361.
  • ——, recent tertiary strata near, 74.
  • Narwal stranded near Boston, 771.
  • ——, fossil near Lewes, 769.
  • Nasmyth, Mr., on nonconductibility of dry sand and clay, 418.
  • Needles of Isle of Wight, 318.
  • Negro physiognomy traced back 3000 years, 660.
  • Neill on whales stranded, 771.
  • Nelson, Lieut, on coral reefs, 798.
  • Neptune, temple of, under water, 516.
  • Neptunists and Vulcanists, rival factions of, 50, 55.
  • Nerbuddah, river, 705.
  • Newbold, Lieut., on mud of Nile, 262.
  • Newfoundland cattle mired in bogs of, 723.
  • Newhaven, its cliffs undermined, 317.
  • New Holland, plants of, 112, 614.
  • ——, animals of, 630.
  • ——, coral reefs of, 776, 791.
  • New Kameni, formation of, 443.
  • New Madrid, U. S., earthquakes at, 350, 466.
  • New Zealand, animals in, 635.
  • ——, tree ferns in, 89.
  • Niagara, Falls of, 214.
  • ——, their recession, 217, 218.
  • ——, height of, 216.
  • Niccolini, M., on Temple of Serapis, 518.
  • Nicolosi destroyed by earthquake, 399.
  • Nile, R., delta of the, 261.
  • ——, cities buried under blown sand near the, 726.
  • ——, swept away by flood of, 753.
  • Nilson, M., on subsidence of Scania, 530.
  • ——, on migrations of eels, 648.
  • Nitrogen in springs, 710.
  • Nomenclature of geology, remarks on, 158.
  • Norfolk, waste of cliffs of, 305.
  • ——, gain of land on coast of, 308.
  • North Cape, drift-wood on, 745.
  • Northumberland, land destroyed by sea in, 303.
  • Norway free from earthquakes, 531.
  • ——, rise of land in, 192, 527, 529.
  • Norwich once situated on an arm of the sea, 307.
  • Norwich Crag, fossils of, 142.
  • Nova Scotia, rise of tides in, 332.
  • Nummulitic limestone, 124.
  • Nymphs, temple of, under water, 516.
  • Nyoe, a new island formed in 1783, 425, 432.

O.

O.

  • Obi, E., fossils on shores of, 81.
  • Ocean, permanency of its level, 518.
  • Odoardi on tertiary strata of Italy, 42.
  • Oersted, discoveries of, 543.
  • Ogygian deluge, 349, 356.
  • Ohio, junction of, with Mississippi, 264.
  • Oldham, Mr., on raised sea beaches in Ireland, 122.
  • Old red sandstone formation, fossils of, 135, 193.
  • Old red sandstone, reptile in, 135.
  • Olivi on fossil remains, 22.
  • Omar, an Arabian writer, 17.
  • Ontario, Lake, distance from Niagara, 216.
  • Oolite, fossils of the, 137.
  • Oolitic structure, recent, in Lancerote, &c., 439.
  • Orang-outang, change of, to man, 575.
  • Orbigny, M. A. de, on Pampean mud, 170.
  • Organic remains, controversy as to real nature of, 19.
  • ——, imbedding of. See Fossillzation.
  • ——, importance of the study of, 60.
  • ——, abrupt transition from those of the secondary to those of the tertiary rocks, 120.
  • ——. See also Fossils.
  • Oriental philosophers, 10.
  • Oriental cosmogony, 7.
  • Orkney Islands, waste of, 301.
  • Orleans, New, ground sinking, 268.
  • ——, trunks of trees in soil of delta, 268.
  • Osseous breccias, 735, 736, 741.
  • Otaheite, coral reefs of, 784, 786.
  • Oujein, buried Indian city, 729.
  • Ouse, R., has filled up an arm of the Sea, 744.
  • Ovid cited, 10, 345.
  • Owen, Prof., on bones of turtles, 772.
  • ——, on the dog and wolf, 584.
  • ——, on tertiary mammalia, 142, 144.
  • ——, quoted, 184.
  • ——, teeth of mammoth, 78.
  • ——, on British fossil mammalia and birds, 137.
  • Owhyhee, 787.
  • Oysters, &c., thrown ashore alive by storm, 773.
  • ——, migrations of, 652.

P.

P.

  • Pacific Ocean, depth of, 104.
  • ——, its height above the Atlantic, 294.
  • ——, subsidence greater than elevation in, 787.
  • ——, coral and volcanic islands of, 354, 776, 780, 787.
  • Palæotherium of Isle of Wight, 142.
  • Palestine shaken by earthquakes, 355.
  • Palissy on organic remains, 23.
  • Pallas on mountains of Siberia, 45.
  • ——, on Caspian Sea, 45.
  • ——, on fossil bones of Siberia, 45, 78, 80.
  • ——, cited, 333.
  • 829 Palmer, Mr., on shingle beaches, 313, 320.
  • Palms, rare in carboniferous group, 88.
  • Pampas, gradual rise of, 170.
  • Panama, tides in Bay of, 295.
  • Papandayang, eruption of, 493.
  • ——, its cone truncated, 493.
  • Papyrus rolls in Herculaneum, 392.
  • Paradise, Burnet on seat of, 32.
  • Parana, R., animals drifted down on rafts by, 641.
  • ——, animals drowned in, 696.
  • Paris basin, formations of the, 121.
  • ——, fossils of the, 142.
  • Parish, Sir W., on inroads of sea during earthquakes, 499, 502.
  • ——, on drifting of animals on floating rafts, 641.
  • ——, on great droughts in S. America, 696.
  • ——, on floods of Parana R., 751.
  • Parma, tertiary strata near, 74.
  • Paroxysmal energy of ancient causes controverted, 174.
  • Parrot, on Caspian Sea, 157.
  • Parrots near Cape Horn, 97.
  • Parry, Captain, highest northern latitude reached by, 98.
  • ——, on migration of polar bear, 640.
  • ——, on animals of Melville Island, 640.
  • Patagonia, tides on coast of, 291.
  • Paviland cave, 737.
  • Peat in delta of Ganges, 280.
  • ——, on preservation of fossils in, 711, 718, 722.
  • ——, distribution of, 719.
  • ——, bogs, bursting of, 724
  • ——, submarine, 725.
  • Peat of Great Dismal Swamp, Virginia, 724.
  • Pembrokeshire, loss of land in, 324.
  • Penco destroyed by earthquake, 499.
  • ——, elevation near, 500.
  • Pennant on waste of Yorkshire coast, 304.
  • ——, on migration of animals, 77, 631, 637.
  • Pentagonal network of mountain chains, M. E. de Beaumont on, 170.
  • Penzance, loss of land near, 323.
  • Permian rocks, reptiles in, 136.
  • Péron on distribution of species, 647.
  • Perrey, M. Alexis, on frequency of earthquakes in winter, 561.
  • Persian Gulf, coral in, 776.
  • Peru, volcanoes in, 347.
  • ——, earthquakes in, 347, 501.
  • Peruvian tradition of a great flood, 8, 502.
  • Peterhead, whale stranded near, 771.
  • Phascolotherium Bucklandi, 139.
  • Philippi, Dr. A., on fossil tertiary shells of Sicily, 183.
  • Phillips, Mr. J., on waste of Yorkshire coast, 304.
  • Phlegræan fields, volcanoes of, 373.
  • Physical Geography. See Geography.
  • Pietra Mala, inflammable gas of, 11.
  • Pigs, instincts of, 595.
  • ——, swim to great distances, 635.
  • ——, fossil, 723.
  • Pilla, M., on Monte Somma, 382.
  • Pindar cited, 398.
  • Pingel, Dr., on subsidence of Greenland, 530.
  • Pisolitic limestone of France, 120.
  • Pitch lake of Trinidad, 250.
  • Plants, carboniferous, wide geographical range, 160.
  • ——, varieties in, produced by horticulture, 588.
  • ——, extent of variation in, 589.
  • ——, their geographical distribution, 97, 112, 613.
  • ——, dispersion of, 618.
  • ——, stations of, 614, 669.
  • ——, equilibrium among, kept up by insects, 672.
  • ——, number of terrestrial, 705.
  • ——, imbedding of, in subaqueous deposits, 742, 765, 770.
  • ——, on number which are now becoming fossil, 745.
  • ——, mineralization of, 747.
  • Plants, fossil, of the coal strata, 87, 115, 133.
  • Plastic clay fossils, 142.
  • Plastic force, fossil shell ascribed to, 20.
  • Playfair on Huttonian theory, 53, 57.
  • ——, on instability of the earth's surface, 212.
  • ——, on gradual rise of Sweden, 523.
  • ——, on form of the earth, 534.
  • Plieninger, Professor, on triassic mammifer, 137.
  • Pliny the Elder, 16.
  • ——, on delta of Rhone, 258.
  • ——, on Islands at the mouth of the Texel, 329..
  • ——, killed by eruption of Vesuvius, A.D. 79, 364.
  • Pliny the Younger, on Vesuvius, 364.
  • Pliocene strata, fossils of, 143.
  • Plot on organic remains, 26.
  • Pluche, theory of, 1732, 83.
  • Plutonic rocks, how formed, 161.
  • ——, action, changes produced by, 176, 178.
  • Po, R., 207.
  • ——, frequently shifts to course, 255.
  • ——, embankment of the, 256.
  • ——, delta of the, 256, 284
  • ——, subsidence in delta of, 257.
  • Poisson, M., on astronomical causes of changes in climate, 127.
  • Polyps. See Zoophytes.
  • Pomerania, fossil ships in, 758.
  • Pompeii, how destroyed, 365, 385, 387.
  • ——, section of the mass enveloping, 386.
  • ——, objects preserved in, 390.
  • ——, infusorial beds covering it, 388.
  • Pont Gibaud, gneiss decomposed at, 248.
  • ——, calcareous springs near, 239.
  • Poole Bay cut into by sea, 319.
  • Popayan, volcanoes and earthquakes in, 349.
  • Portland, fossil ammonites of, 28.
  • ——, its peninsula wasting. 319.
  • Port Royal, subsidence of, 504, 517, 691, 762.
  • Porto Praya, Azores, calcareous stratum, 436.
  • Portugal, earthquakes in, 358.
  • Porzio on formation of Monte Nuovo, 369, 371.
  • Post-tertiary formations, 184.
  • Precession of the equinoxes, 100, 537.
  • Prentice, Lieut, on coral reef in Maldives, 778.
  • Pressure, effects of, 171.
  • Prestwich, Mr., on artesian wells, 234.
  • Prevost Const., on Stonefield fossil mammalia, 138.
  • ——, Const., on gypseous springs, 245.
  • ——, on rents formed by upheaval, 371.
  • ——, on new island in Mediterranean, 433.
  • ——, on geological causes, 718.
  • ——, on osseous breccias of caves, 736.
  • Prevost, Pierre, on radiation of heat, 93.
  • Prevost, Mr. J. L., on number of wrecked vessels, 756.
  • Primary fossiliferous rocks, fossils of, 114.
  • Priscodelphinus, cetacean, of chalk, 145.
  • Pritchard, Dr., on Egyptian cosmogony, 8.
  • ——, on recent origin of man, 147.
  • ——, on hybrid races, 602.
  • ——, on facial angle, 608.
  • ——, on distribution of animals, 629, 631.
  • Procida, island of, ancient writers on, 360.
  • Progressive development, theory of, 130-153.
  • ——, in animals, Lamarck's theory of, 567.
  • Provinces, geographical, of Testacea, 649.
  • Provinces, zoological and land quadrupeds, 631.
  • Pterodactyles, 137.
  • Pulo Nias, upraised coral in, 794.
  • Purbeck, its peninsula wasting, 319.
  • Pursh on plants of United States, 614.
  • Puzzuoli, Temple of Serapis near, 507.
  • ——, inland cliffs near, 508, 510.
  • ——, date of re-elevation of coast of, 515, 518.
  • ——, encroachment of sea near, 515.
  • ——, coast near, now subsiding, 516.
  • Pyrenees, their relative age, height, &c., 120, 166.
  • Pythagoras, system of, 10.
  • ——, on Etna, 345.

Q.

Q.

  • 830 Quadrumana, fossil, 144.
  • Quadrupeds, domestic, multiply in America, 584, 685.
  • ——, regions of indigenous, 630, 636.
  • ——, imbedding of terrestrial, 749.
  • Quaggas, migrations of, 638.
  • Quebec, climate of, 95.
  • ——, earthquakes in, 470.
  • Queenstown, Canada, table land terminates at, 216.
  • Quintero elevated by earthquake of 1822, 457.
  • Quiriui, theory of, 25.
  • Quito, earthquakes and volcanoes in, 346, 348, 469.

R.

R.

  • Rabenstein cave, 736.
  • Race of Alderney, its velocity, 293.
  • "Races," tidal currents so called, 341.
  • Raffles, Sir S., cited, 465, 599.
  • Rafts, drift-timber in Mississippi, &c., 267.
  • Rain, action of, 713.
  • ——, diminished by felling of forests, 713.
  • ——, fall of, in basin of Ganges, 278.
  • ——, Huttonian theory of, 199.
  • ——, fall of, varying with latitude, 199.
  • ——, fall of, in Eastern Bengal, 200.
  • Rain-prints, recent, on mud in Nova Scotia, 202.
  • Raised beaches, 184.
  • Ramree, volcanic island, 354.
  • Raspe on islands shifting their position (note), 11.
  • ——, his theory, 1763, 42, 43, 48.
  • Rats, migrations of, 637.
  • ——, introduced by man into America, 663, 686.
  • Rawlinson, Col., on delta of Tigris, 285.
  • Ray, his physico-theology, &c., 30, 31.
  • ——, cited, 645, 683.
  • Reaumur on insects, 674
  • Reculver cliff; action of sea on, 312.
  • Rocupero on flowing of lava, 401.
  • Red Crag, fossils of, 142.
  • Redman, J. B., on changes of English coast, 315, 316, 319.
  • Red marl, supposed universality of, 158.
  • Red River, new lakes formed by, 269.
  • ——, drift-wood in, 267.
  • ——, and Mississippi, their junction recent, 264, 284.
  • Red Sea, level of, and of Mediterranean, 294.
  • ——, coral reefs of, 777, 784.
  • Reefs, coral, outline destroyed by denudation, 795.
  • Refrigeration, Leibnitz's theory of, 26.
  • ——, causes which might produce the extreme of, 106.
  • Reid, Col., on motion of shingle beaches, 320.
  • Rein-deer, geographical range of, 637.
  • ——, migrations of, 640.
  • ——, imported into Iceland, 686.
  • Rennel, Major, on delta of Ganges, 275.
  • ——, on delta of Nile, 261.
  • ——, on currents, 95, 97, 291, 292, 293.
  • ——, on the tide-wave called "the Bore," 333.
  • Rennel, Mr., on delta of Ganges, 275.
  • Rennie, Rev. Dr., on peat, and fossils in peat, 718, 719, 720, 722.
  • Reptiles, their geographical distribution, 645.
  • ——, their powers of diffusion, 645.
  • ——, in carboniferous epoch, 136.
  • ——, in Ireland, 645.
  • ——, imbedded in subaqueous strata, 748, 771.
  • ——, fossil, in old red sandstone, 135.
  • ——, in coal, 136.
  • Rhine, R., description, of its course, 325.
  • ——, its delta, 326.
  • ——, tuff made of siliceous cases of infusoria, 388.
  • Rhinoceros, fossil, food of, 80.
  • Rhone, delta of, in Mediterranean, 258.
  • ——, delta of, in Lake of Geneva, 189, 252, 286.
  • ——, deposits at its confluence with the Arve, 288.
  • Rhone, a cannon in calcareous rock in its delta, 759.
  • Richardson, Sir J., on rocks near Mackenzie River, 115.
  • ——, on sheep of Rocky Mountains, 598.
  • ——, on distribution of animals, 640, 645.
  • ——, on drift timber, in Slave Lake, 743.
  • ——, on arctic fauna, 634.
  • ——, on diffusion of fish, 647.
  • ——, on isothermal lines, 94.
  • Richardson, Mr. W., on Herne Bay, 312.
  • Riddell, Dr., on sediment of Mississippi, 273.
  • Rive, M. de la, on terrestrial magnetism, 543.
  • River-ice, carrying power of, 219.
  • Rivers, difference in the sediment of, 189, 258.
  • ——, sinuosities of, 205.
  • ——, submarine, in Thessaly, &c., 357.
  • ——, when confluent, do not occupy bed of proportionally larger surface, 207.
  • Robert, M., on geysers of Iceland, 246.
  • Robertson, Capt., on mud volcanoes, 449.
  • Rockhall bank, recent deposits on, 778.
  • Rocks, specific gravity of, 206.
  • ——, difference in texture of older and newer, 175.
  • ——, altered by subterranean gases, 248.
  • ——, origin of the primary, 176.
  • ——, persistency of mineral character in, 157.
  • ——, older, why most solid and disturbed, 162.
  • ——, action of frost on, 221, 231.
  • ——, transportation of, by ice, 155, 219.
  • ——, grooved by glacial action, 155, 227, 229.
  • Rogers, Prof., on Appalachian chain, 559.
  • Roman roads under water in Bay of Baiæ, 517.
  • Romney Marsh, gained from sea, 316.
  • Rose, M. G., on hornblende and augite, 449.
  • Ross, Sir J., on cold of antarctic regions, 99.
  • ——, obtained soundings at depth of 27,600 feet, 104.
  • ——, confirms Cook as to antarctic ice, 125.
  • ——, on icebergs, 98, 229.
  • Rossberg, slide of the, 732.
  • Rotation of the earth, currents caused by, 296.
  • ——, of crops, 670, 720.
  • Rother, River, vessel found in its old bed, 316, 758.
  • Royle, Mr., 81.
  • Runn of Cutch described, 463.
  • Rye formerly destroyed by sea, 316.

S.

S.

  • Saarbuck, reptiles in coal strata at, 136.
  • Sabine, Capt., on well at Chiswick, 234
  • ——, on waters of Amazon discoloring the sea, 342.
  • Sabine, Col., on solar magnetic period, 129, 544.
  • Sabrina, island of, 432.
  • Saco, R., flood on, 209.
  • Sahrunpore, buried town near, 731.
  • St. Andrew's, loss of land at, 303.
  • ——, gun-barrel, fossil, near, 760.
  • St. Domingo, hot springs caused by earthquake in, 494.
  • ——, fossil human skeleton in, 758.
  • St. Helena, tides at, 291.
  • St. Jago, earthquake at, 457.
  • St. Katherine's Docks, a fossil vessel found in, 758.
  • St. Lawrence, Gulf of, earthquakes in, 470.
  • ——, rocks drifted by ice in the, 220.
  • St. Maura, earthquakes in, 474.
  • St. Michael, siliceous springs of, 246.
  • St. Michael's Mount, 323.
  • St. Paul, volcanic island, 446.
  • St. Vincent's, volcanoes of, 466.
  • ——, counter-currents in the air proved by eruption in, 106.
  • ——, boa constrictor conveyed on drift-wood to, 646.
  • Salt, on its deposition in the Mediterranean, 334.
  • Salt springs 18, 247.
  • Saltholm, island of, 520.
  • Samothracian deluge, 356.
  • Sand bars along western coast of Adriatic, 257.
  • ——, drift, estuaries blocked up by, 307.
  • 831 Sand, imbedding of towns, &c. in, 726.
  • ——, cones of thrown up during earthquake, 483.
  • Sandown Bay, excavated by sea, 318.
  • Sandwich Islands volcanoes, 354, 372, 383, 429, 548, 552.
  • Sandwich Land, perpetual snow to level of sea-beach in, 99.
  • San Filippo, travertin of, 241.
  • San Lio, on Etna, fissures in plain of, 399.
  • Santa Maria, island of, raised 10 feet, 455.
  • Santorin, geological structure of, 445.
  • ——, chart and section of, 442.
  • ——, new islands in Gulf of, 441.
  • Saracens, learning of the, 17.
  • Saussure on the Alps and Jura, 45.
  • ——, on glaciers in Alps, 223.
  • Savanna la Mar, swept away by sea, 731.
  • Saxicava rugosa, cosmopolite shell, 650.
  • Scandinavia called an island by the ancients, 520.
  • ——, gradual rise of, 520, 563.
  • ——. See Sweden.
  • Scania, gradual subsidence of, 530.
  • Scacchi, Sig., on temple of Serapis, 516.
  • ——, on origin of Monte Nuovo, 371.
  • Scheuchzer, his theory, 1708, 33.
  • Schmerling, Dr., on fossils in caves, 737.
  • Schwabe, M., on spots in the sun, 129, 544.
  • Sciacca, island of. See Graham Island.
  • Scilla on organic remains, 1670, 24.
  • Scilla, rock of, 488.
  • Scoresby, Capt, on the Gulf stream, 96.
  • ——, on formation of field ice, 108.
  • ——, on weight of rocks transported by icebergs, 227.
  • ——, cited, 640, 743.
  • Scotland, floods in, 207, 750.
  • ——, colder climate indicated by newest tertiary strata of, 125.
  • ——, waste of islands and coast of, 298.
  • ——, slight earthquakes felt in, 358.
  • ——, peat-mosses of, 720, 723.
  • ——, marl lakes of, 752, 766, 770.
  • Scrope, Mr. G. P., on eruption of Vesuvius in 1822, 375.
  • ——, on columnar basalts of Vesuvius, 385.
  • ——, on pisolitic globules at Pompeii, 387.
  • ——, on eruptions of Etna, 408, 410.
  • ——, on cause of convexity of plain of Malpais, 429.
  • ——, on connection between state of atmosphere and earthquakes, 561.
  • Sea does not change its level, but land, 15.
  • ——, its influence on climate, 97.
  • ——, area covered by, 124.
  • ——, its encroachments on coasts, 298, 302, 324.
  • ——, its rise and retreat during earthquakes, 407.
  • Sea-beaches, raised, in Ireland, 122.
  • ——, progressive motion of, 316.
  • Seals, migration of, 642.
  • Sea-weed, banks formed by drift, 622, 770.
  • Secondary rocks, fossils of the, 86.
  • ——, origin of the, 117.
  • Sedgwick, Professor, on the Hartz mountains, 48.
  • ——, on tertiary deposits of the Alps, 119.
  • ——, on the antagonist power of vegetation, 711.
  • ——, on organic remains in fissures, 740.
  • ——, on diluvial waves, 423.
  • Sediment of the Mississippi, 272.
  • ——, laws governing deposition o£ 188, 342.
  • ——, in river water, 270.
  • ——, of Ganges compared to lavas of Etna, 283.
  • ——, rate of subsidence of some kinds of, 342.
  • ——, area over which it may be transported by currents, 343.
  • Sedimentary deposition, causes which occasion a shifting of the areas of, 189.
  • Seeds, vitality of, 587.
  • ——, of Leguminosæ adapted for water-carriage, 622.
  • Serapis, temple of, 507.
  • ——, ground-plan of environs of, 507.
  • ——, date of its re-elevation, 512.
  • ——, now again subsiding, 516.
  • ——, worship of, in Italy, 512.
  • Serres, E. R. A., on changes in brain of fœtus, 609.
  • Serres, E. Marcel de, on fossil human remains, 738.
  • Severn, tides in estuary of, 291.
  • ——, gain of land in its estuary, 324.
  • Shakspeare's cliff, waste of, 314.
  • "Shambles," a shoal off Portland Bill, 32.
  • Sharpe, Mr. D., on earthquake of Lisbon, 496.
  • Sheep, multiplication of, in South America, 686.
  • Shell marl, fossils in, 752, 766, 769.
  • Shells, fossil of older strata buried in newer or recent beds, 775. See Testacea.
  • Sheppey, waste of cliffs, 312.
  • Shetland Islands, action of the sea on, 298.
  • ——, rock masses drifted by sea in, 298.
  • ——, effect of lightning on rocks in, 299.
  • ——, formation in progress near, 774.
  • Shingle beaches, 318, 320.
  • Ships, number of British, wrecked annually, 754, 755.
  • ——, fossil, 316, 725, 758.
  • Siberia, rhinoceros entire in frozen soil of, 45, 82.
  • ——, map of, 79.
  • ——, the Bengal tiger found in, 78.
  • ——, lowland of, 78, 83, 85.
  • ——, drift timber on coast of, 745.
  • Siberian lowlands, climate of, 83.
  • ——, mammoths, 80.
  • Sicily, earthquakes in, 357, 470, 477, 479, 503, 736.
  • ——, geological structure of, 74, 167, 183.
  • ——, mud volcanoes of, 447.
  • Sienna, fossil shells of, 39, 74.
  • Sigillariæ, structure of, 88.
  • Silex, deposited by springs, 246.
  • Silliman, Professor, cited, 759.
  • Silurian rocks, wide range of the fossils, 160.
  • ——, fauna, no land or freshwater plants in, 134.
  • ——, horizontal, 187.
  • ——, altered, 177.
  • ——, strata formed in deep seas, 117.
  • Simeto, R., lava excavated by, 213.
  • Sindree, changes caused by earthquakes of 1819, near, 461, 464, 761.
  • ——, view of the fort of, before the earthquake (see Pl. xi.), 461.
  • ——, its appearance in 1838, 463.
  • Skaptâr Jokul, eruption of, 425.
  • Slave Lake, drift timber in, 743.
  • Sleswick, waste of coast of, 330, 694.
  • Sligo, bursting of a peat-moss in, 724.
  • Sloane, Sir H., on earthquake in Jamaica, 505.
  • ——, on dispersion of plants, 621.
  • Smith, William, agreement of his system with Werner's, 48.
  • ——, his "Tabular View of the British Strata," 1790, 58.
  • ——, his map of England, 58.
  • ——, priority of his arrangement, 58.
  • Smith, Mr., of Jordan Hill, on the colder climate of newest tertiary period, 126.
  • ——, on temple of Serapis, 516.
  • Smyrna, volcanic country round, 355.
  • Smyth, Capt. W. H., on the Mediterranean, 45, 259, 296, 511.
  • ——, on height Of Etna, 396.
  • ——, on Straits of Gibraltar, 333, 336.
  • ——, on depth of sea from which Graham Island rose, 432.
  • ——, on floating islands of drift-wood, 641.
  • ——, on drifting of birds by the wind, 645.
  • ——, on diffusion of insects, 657.
  • ——, on average number of British ships lost, from 1793 to 1829, 755.
  • ——, found shells at great depths between Gibraltar and Ceuta, 773.
  • Snow, height of perpetual, in the Andes, 112.
  • ——, in Himalaya mountains, 112.
  • ——, lowest limits of perpetual, at equator, 222.
  • ——, lowest limits of perpetual, at Swiss Alps, 222.
  • Sodertelje, buried hut in canal of, 524, 528.
  • Soil, its influence on plants, 590.
  • Soils, on formation of, 709.
  • ——, influence of plants on, 670.
  • 832 Soldani, on microscopic shells of Mediterranean, 44.
  • ——, on the Paris basin, 44.
  • Solent, its channel widening, 318.
  • Solfatara, lake of, 243.
  • ——, volcano, 358, 363, 367, 385.
  • Solitaire, recently extinct bird, 684.
  • Solway Moss, 723.
  • Solway Firth, animals washed by river floods into, 760.
  • Somersetshire, land gained in, 324.
  • ——, submarine forest on coast of, 323.
  • Somerville, Mrs., on depth of ocean, 104.
  • Somma, escarpment of, 381.
  • ——, dikes of, 382.
  • ——, supposed section of Vesuvius and, 381.
  • Sorbonne, College of the, 39.
  • Sorting power of water, 287.
  • South Carolina, earthquake in, 466.
  • South Downs, waste of plastic clay on, 317.
  • Spain, earthquakes in, 358.
  • Spallanzani on effects of heat on seeds, 621.
  • ——, on flight of birds, 644.
  • Species, definition of the term, 567.
  • ——, Linnæus on constancy of, 568.
  • ——, Lamarck's theory of transmutation of, 567, 580, 699.
  • ——, reality of, in nature, 583, 591, 592, 611.
  • ——, geographical distribution of, 612.
  • ——, theories respecting their origin, 666, 703.
  • ——, Brocchi on extinction of, 668.
  • ——, reciprocal influence of aquatic and terrestrial, 676.
  • ——, their successive creation and extinction, 678, 689, 707.
  • ——, effect of changes in geography, climate, &c., on their distribution, 105, 690, 697.
  • ——, superior longevity of molluscous, 76.
  • Specific centres, doctrine of, 630.
  • Spence, Mr., on insects, cited, 606, 655, 673.
  • Spitzbergen, glaciers of, 96.
  • Spix, M., on animals drifted by Amazon, 641.
  • ——, on Brazil, 682.
  • Spontaneous generation, theory of, 22.
  • Springs, origin of, 232.
  • ——, the theory of, illustrated by bored wells, 233.
  • ——, most abundant in volcanic regions, 237.
  • ——, affected by earthquake, 237, 453, 456, 483, 494.
  • ——, transporting power of, 238.
  • ——, calcareous, 239.
  • ——, sulphureous and gypseous, 245.
  • ——, siliceous, 246.
  • ——, ferruginous, 249.
  • ——, brine, 247.
  • ——, carbonated, 248.
  • ——, petroleum, 250.
  • Squirrels, migrations of, 637.
  • Stabiæ, buried city of, 394.
  • Stalagmite alternating with alluvium in caves, 737.
  • Stars, variable splendor of, 128.
  • Statical figure of the earth, 534, 544.
  • Stations of plants, description of, 614.
  • ——, of animals, 677.
  • Stelluti on organic remains, 23.
  • Steno, opinions of, 23.
  • Stephenson on eruption in Iceland, 425.
  • Stephenson, Mr. R., on level of Red Sea and Mediterranean, 294.
  • Stevenson, Mr., on drift stones on Bell-Rock, 302.
  • ——, on the German Ocean, 315, 340.
  • ——, on waste of cliffs, 324.
  • Stockholm, rise of land near, 526, 527.
  • Stokes, Mr., on mineralization of plants, 747.
  • Stonesfleld, fossils of, 138, 145.
  • Storm of November, 1824, effect of, 317, 318, 320.
  • Strabo cited, 14, 260, 355, 361.
  • ——, geology of, 14.
  • Strachey, Capt, R., on delta of Ganges, 283.
  • Straits of Dover, formation of, 315.
  • ——, their depth, 315.
  • Straits of Gibraltar, currents in, &c., 333, 335.
  • Strata, laws governing deposition of, 188.
  • ——, slow deposition of, proved by fossils, 154.
  • ——, on consolidation of, 175.
  • Stratifications in deltas, causes of, 287.
  • ——, of debris deposited by currents, 288.
  • ——, unconformable, inferences derived from, 187.
  • Strabo, hypothesis of, 14.
  • Strickland, Mr., on tertiary strata, Cropthorn, 76.
  • ——, on dodo, 684.
  • Stromboli, its appearance during Calabrlan earthquakes, 488.
  • ——, constancy in eruption, 546, 561.
  • Stufas, jets of steam in volcanic regions, 237, 546.
  • Stutchbury, Mr., on coral islands, 778, 782.
  • Subapennine strata, 74.
  • ——, early Italian geologists on, 42, 71.
  • Submarine forests, 303, 323, 746.
  • ——, peat, 724, 770.
  • ——, rivers, 357.
  • ——, volcanoes, 431, 454.
  • ——, eruptions in mid Atlantic, 436.
  • Subsidence of land, 460, 465, 470, 477, 495, 503, 504, 507, 691, 761, 762.
  • ——, great areas of, 170, 790.
  • ——, greater than elevation, 563, 787.
  • ——, simultaneous in Miocene epoch, 192.
  • ——, of land, delta of Mississippi, 271.
  • ——, of coral islands, slow and uniform, 791.
  • Subterranean movements, uniformity of, 186.
  • ——, movements near New Madrid, 1811-12, 270.
  • Suffolk, cliffs undermined, 309.
  • ——, tertiary strata of, 142.
  • Sulphuric acid, lake of, in Java, 353.
  • Sulphureous springs, 245.
  • Sumatra, volcanoes in, 354.
  • ——, animals destroyed by river floods in, 751.
  • Sumbawa, subsidence in island of, 1815, 464, 762.
  • ——, ashes, transported to great distances by eruptions of, 106.
  • Sun, variations in spots of, 129.
  • Sunda, Isles of, volcanic region of, 350.
  • Sunderbunds, part of delta of Ganges, 276.
  • "Sunk country," west of New Madrid in U. S., 467.
  • Superior, Lake, deltas of, 254
  • ——, recent deposits in, 254, 768.
  • ——, its depth, extent, &c., 254.
  • ——, bursting of, would cause a flood, 156.
  • Sussex, waste of its coast, 317.
  • Sutlej, R., fossils near, 6.
  • Swanage Bay, excavated by sea, 318.
  • Sweden, gradual rise of, 520, 563.
  • ——, gradual subsidence of south of, 530.
  • ——, earthquakes in, 531.
  • ——, land rising, 192.
  • ——, See also Scandinavia.
  • Switzerland, towns destroyed by landslips in, 732.
  • Syria, earthquakes in, 355, 453.

T.

T.

  • Tacitus cited, 364.
  • Tagliamento, R., delta of the, 258.
  • Targioni, on geology of Tuscany, 40.
  • Tartary, volcanoes in, 355.
  • Taxodium distichum in Great Dismal Swamp, 725.
  • Tay, estuary of, encroachment of sea in, 302.
  • ——, submarine forests in, 303.
  • Taylor, Mr. R. C., on waste of cliff's, 306.
  • ——, on gain of land on coast of Norfolk, 308.
  • ——, on caves in isle of Cuba, 741.
  • Tchihatchoff, M., map of Italy, 123.
  • Teissier, M., on human bones in caves, &c., 739.
  • Temperature, great changes in, 92.
  • ——, difference of, in places in same latitudes, 95.
  • ——, warmer in tertiary periods, 75.
  • ——, oscillation of, 125.
  • ——, See Climate.
  • Temples, buried, in Egypt, 726.
  • ——, under water in Bay of Baiæ, 518.
  • ——, buried in Cashmere, 762.
  • Teneriffe, volcanic eruptions in, 439.
  • 833 Terra del Fuego, fauna of, 141.
  • Terranuova, subsidence near, 470.
  • ——, fault in the tower of, 478.
  • ——, landslips near, 485.
  • Tertiary formations, general remarks on, 141, 182, 183.
  • ——, geographical changes implied by, 118.
  • ——, glacial in Scotland, 126.
  • ——, origin of successive periods, 182.
  • ——, circumstances under which these and the secondary formations may have originated, 117, 118.
  • ——, fossils of the newest, 183.
  • ——, fossil mammals of successive, 142.
  • ——, formations of England, 76, 142.
  • ——, of the Paris basin, 142.
  • ——, deposits, climate of warmer, 86.
  • Testacea, their geographical distribution, 649.
  • ——, fossil, importance of, 183.
  • ——, marine, imbedding of, 768.
  • ——, freshwater, 770.
  • ——, burrowing, 773.
  • ——, longevity of species of, 76.
  • ——, number of recent, in different tertiary periods, 142, 183.
  • Texel, waste of islands near the, 328.
  • Thames, valley of, tertiary strata in, 76.
  • ——, gain and loss of land in its estuary, 312.
  • ——, tide in its estuary, 338.
  • ——, buried vessels in alluvial plain of the, 758.
  • Thanet, Isle of, loss of land in, 313.
  • Thermo-electricity, 543.
  • Thibet, yak or wild ox of, in ice, 85.
  • Thomson, Dr. T., on Western Himalaya and Thibet, 763.
  • ——, on buried temples in Cashmere, 763.
  • Thrace subject to earthquakes, 355.
  • Thury, M. Hericart de, on artesian wells, 234, 236.
  • Thylacotherium Prevostii, 138.
  • Tiber, growth of its delta, 243.
  • Tide wave of the Atlantic, 308.
  • Tides, height to which they rise, 279, 290.
  • ——, effect of winds on the, 295.
  • ——, effects of, on wells near London, 233.
  • ——, their destroying and transporting power, 291.
  • ——, their reproductive effects, 337.
  • ——, and currents, drifting remains of animals by, 753.
  • Tiedemann on changes in brain of fœtus, 609.
  • Tiger of Bengal found in Siberia, 77.
  • Tigris and Euphrates, their union a modern event, 284.
  • Tigris, river, delta of, advancing, 284.
  • Tilesius on Siberian mammoth, 81.
  • Time, prepossessions in regard to the duration of past, 62.
  • Tivoli, flood at, 211.
  • ——, travertin of, 244.
  • Tomboro, volcano, eruption of, 465.
  • ——, town of, submerged, 465.
  • Torre del Greco overflowed by lava, 394.
  • ——, columnar lavas of, 384.
  • Torrents, action of, in widening valleys, 204.
  • Torres' Strait, volcano of, 792.
  • Totten, Col., on expansion of rocks by heat, 562.
  • Tournal, M., on French caves, 738, 739.
  • Towns destroyed by landslips, 732.
  • Trade-winds, 106, 295.
  • Traditions of losses of land, 324, 327.
  • ——, of floods, 500, 501.
  • Transition texture, 176.
  • ——, formations, 177.
  • Trap rocks of many different ages, 160.
  • Travertin of the Elsa, 239.
  • ——, of San Vignone, 240.
  • ——, of San Filippo, 241.
  • ——, spheroidal structure of, 242.
  • ——, compared to English magnesian limestone, 243.
  • ——, of Tivoli, 244.
  • Travertin politic, recent, in Lancerote, 439.
  • Tree-ferns, distribution of, 88.
  • Tree-ferns, extend more south than north of equator, 86.
  • Trees, longevity of, 422.
  • Trias, fossil mammifer of, 137.
  • Trimmer, Mr., on recent marine shells in Wales, 122.
  • Trinidad, subsidence in, 250.
  • ——, pitch lake of, 250.
  • Tripergola, 370, 371, 395.
  • Tripolitza, plain of, breccias in, 734.
  • Trollhattan, 527.
  • Truncation of volcanic cones, 352, 493.
  • Tufa. See Travertin.
  • Tuff, infusorial, 388.
  • Turner, Dr., on decomposition of felspar, 247.
  • Turtles, migrations of, 645.
  • ——, eggs of, fossil, 771.
  • Turton cited, 646.
  • Tuscany, geology of, 23, 40.
  • ——, calcareous springs of, 239.
  • Tyrol, Dolomieu on the, 49.

U.

U.

  • Uddevalla, upraised deposits at, 184, 527
  • Uliah Bund, formation of the, 462.
  • Ulloa cited, 501, 502, 685.
  • Unconformable strata, inferences derived from, 187.
  • Uniformity of laws of nature, 71, 149, 373.
  • ——, of system of past changes in animate and inanimate world, 181.
  • Universal formations, theory of, 49, 154.
  • Universal ocean, theory of, 26, 34.
  • ——, disproved by organic remains, 191.
  • Upsala, strata near, 528.

V.

V.

  • Val d'Arno, Upper, effect of destruction of forests in, 712.
  • Val del Bove on Etna described, 403.
  • ——, form, composition, and origin of dikes in, 406.
  • ——, lavas and breccias of the, 411.
  • ——, origin of the, 413.
  • ——, floods in, 411.
  • Val di Calanna, 405, 407, 410.
  • Val di Noto, Dolomieu on the, 49.
  • Valdivia, earthquake at, 453.
  • Valenciennes, M., on fish not crossing the Atlantic, 647.
  • Valley, newly formed in Georgia, U. S., 205.
  • Valleys, Targioni on origin of, 40.
  • ——, excavation of, in Central France, 213.
  • ——, of elevation, section of, 420.
  • ——, on Etna, account of, 404.
  • ——, the excavation of, assisted by earthquakes, 484.
  • Vallisneri on the origin of springs, 33.
  • ——, on marine deposits of Italy, 34.
  • ——, cited, 34, 35, 52.
  • Valparaiso, changes caused by earthquakes at, 457, 517, 761.
  • Van Dieman's Land, climate of, 97.
  • Vedas, sacred hymns of, 4.
  • Vegetable soil, why it does not increase, 709.
  • ——, how formed, 710.
  • Vegetation, luxuriant, not required to support
  • large animals, 82.
  • ——, centres of, 703.
  • ——, its conservative influence, 710, 711.
  • ——, its influence on climate, 713.
  • Veins, mineral, on their formation, 484.
  • ——, of lava. See Dikes.
  • Verneuil, M. de, on lowland of Siberia, 84.
  • Verona, fossils of, 20, 22, 34.
  • ——, Arduino on mountains of, 41.
  • Verstegan, on separation of England from France, 315, 642.
  • Vertebrated animals in oldest strata, 135.
  • Vessels, fossil. See Ships.
  • Vesta, temple of, 212.
  • 834 Vesuvius, excavation of tuff on, 213.
  • ——, history of, 263, 374.
  • ——, eruptions of, 364, 374.
  • ——, dikes of, 379.
  • ——, lava of, 384.
  • ——, structure and origin of the cone of, 383.
  • ——, and Somma, probable section of, 381.
  • ——, volcanic alluvium on, 728.
  • Vicentin, Dolomieu on the, 49.
  • ——, submarine lavas of the, 71.
  • Victoria land, skirted by ice, 99.
  • Vidal, Capt., on Rockhall bank, 773.
  • Villages buried by landslips, 732.
  • Virlet, M., on Samothracian deluge, 356.
  • ——, on volcanoes of Greece, 355.
  • ——, on Santorin, 443, 445, 446.
  • ——, on corrosion of rocks by gases, 733.
  • ——, on human bones imbedded in Morea, 735.
  • Vivarais, basalts of the, 48.
  • Volcanic action, defined, 345.
  • ——, power adequate to effect lateral pressure, 172.
  • ——, lines, 169, 352.
  • ——, craters in Galapagos with southern side lowest, 783.
  • ——, action, uniformity of, 162, 711.
  • ——, cones, truncation of, 352, 493.
  • ——, their perfect state no proof of relative age, 712.
  • ——, conglomerates, 438.
  • ——, dikes. See Dikes.
  • ——, eruptions, causes of, 542.
  • ——, average number of, per annum, 450.
  • ——, formations, fossils in, 349, 728.
  • ——, products, mineral composition of, 449.
  • ——, regions, their geographical boundaries, 346.
  • ——, map showing extent of, 351.
  • ——, rocks, subterranean, 178, 450.
  • ——, of all geological periods, 160.
  • Volcanoes, safety-valves according to Strabo, 15.
  • ——, remarks on their position, 346, 355.
  • ——, and earthquakes, effects of same causes, 345.
  • ——, agency of water in, 545.
  • ——, mode of computing the age of, 420.
  • ——, sometimes inactive for centuries, 346, 421.
  • ——, of Sandwich Islands, 354, 372, 548, 383, 429.
  • ——, chemical theory of, 546.
  • ——, mud, 447.
  • ——, "no safety-valves," Dana on, 553.
  • Voltaire on systems of geology, 54.
  • Volterra, Mattani, on fossils of, 34.
  • Von Baer, Prof., on frozen soil of Siberia, 84.
  • ——, on ice-drifted rocks, 231.
  • Von Buch on rise of land in Sweden, 523, 526.
  • ——, on volcanic lines, 352.
  • ——, on volcanoes of Greece, 355.
  • ——, on formation of Monte Nuovo, 369.
  • ——, on Vesuvius and Somma, 367, 380, 382, 384
  • ——, on eruption in Lancerote, 436.
  • ——, on glaciers, 228.
  • ——, on new islands, 468.
  • ——, on volcanic regions, 346.
  • Von Hoff. See Hoff.
  • Vulcanists and Neptunists, factions of, 50, 55.
  • Vultur, Mount, 356.
  • Vultures, range of, 643.

W.

W.

  • Wallerius, theory of, 45.
  • Wallich, Dr., on Ava fossils, 28.
  • ——, on wood in peat near Calcutta, 280.
  • Warping, land gained by, 288, 339.
  • Water, action of running, 204.
  • ——, its power on freezing, 204
  • ——, excavating power of, 204
  • ——, transporting power of, 204
  • ——, sorting power of, 286.
  • ——, agency of, in volcanoes, 548.
  • Waterhouse, Mr., of British Museum, on provinces of indigenous land quadrupeds, 631.
  • Wealden strata, fossils of, 117, 137, 140.
  • Webster, Dr., of Nova Scotia, on rain-prints, 202.
  • Wells, artesian, 233.
  • Wener, Lake, strata near, 527.
  • Werner, Professor of Mineralogy at Freyberg, 1775, 46.
  • ——, his lecture, 47.
  • ——, on granite of the Hartz, 47.
  • ——, principal merit of his system, 48.
  • ——, technical terms of, 58.
  • ——, on transition rocks, 176.
  • West Indian land quadrupeds, 634
  • West Indies, earthquakes in, 29, 350, 505.
  • ——, active volcanoes in, 350.
  • Whales stranded, 771.
  • Whewell, Rev. Dr., on modern progress of geology, 59.
  • ——, on the tides, 332.
  • Whirlwinds, violent, during eruption in Sumbawa, 465.
  • Whirlwind, dispersion of seeds by, 619.
  • Whiston, his theory of the earth, 32.
  • White Mountains, landslips in the, 209.
  • Whitehurst, theory of, 1778, 45.
  • ——, on subsidence at Lisbon, 495.
  • Wildenow on diffusion of plants by man, 626.
  • ——, on centres of vegetable creation, 703.
  • Wilkinson, Sir J. G., on deposits of Nile, 262.
  • ——, on sand drift in Egypt, 726.
  • Wilson, Prof., on cosmogony of Vedas, 4.
  • Winds, trade, 106, 295.
  • ——, currents caused by the, 293.
  • ——, sand drifted by the, 307, 726.
  • Wolf, and dog, distinct species, 585.
  • ——, hybrids between the, 601.
  • ——, drifted to sea on ice, 640.
  • ——, extirpated in Great Britain, 683.
  • Wollaston, Dr., on water of Mediterranean, 334.
  • Wood, Mr. S., on fossil quadrumana, 144.
  • Wood impregnated with salt water when sunk to great depths, 743.
  • ——, drift, 90, 268, 640, 743.
  • ——, converted into lignite, 759.
  • Woodward, theory of, 31, 84, 54, 66.
  • Wrecks, number of, annually, 754, 755.

X.

X.

  • Xanthus, the Lydian, his theory, 14.

Y.

Y.

  • Yak, wild ox of Thibet, frozen in ice, 85.
  • Yakutzt, frozen soil of, 84.
  • Yaou, flood of, 7.
  • Yarmouth, estuary silted up at, 307.
  • ——, rise of the tide at, 291, 307.
  • Yenesei, R., fossils on banks of, 79.
  • Yorkshire, bones of mammoth in, 76.
  • ——, waste of its coasts, 303.
  • Young, Dr., on effects of compression at earth's centre, 536.

Z.

Z.

  • Zante, earthquakes in island of, 474
  • Zealand, New, number of ferns, 116.
  • ——, resemblance of plants with ancient carboniferous flora, 116.
  • ——, length and breadth of, 116.
  • Zeuglodon, eocene cetacea, 145.
  • Zoological provinces how formed, 666.
  • ——, why not more blended together, 668.
  • Zoophytes, their geographical distribution, 651.
  • ——, their powers of diffusion, 654
  • ——, abundance of, 706.
  • ——, which form coral reefs, 776.
  • Zuyder Zee, formation, 328.
  • ——, great mosses on the site of, 327.

D. APPLETON & CO. PUBLISH,

UNIFORM WITH "THE PRINCIPLES OF GEOLOGY,"

A MANUAL

of

ELEMENTARY GEOLOGY;

Or, the Ancient Changes of the Earth and its Inhabitants,

AS ILLUSTRATED BY GEOLOGICAL MONUMENTS.

BY SIR CHARLES LYELL, M. A., F. R. S.,

Author of "Principles of Geology" &c., &c.
Reprinted from the last London, Entirely Revised Edition. Illustrated with Five Hundred Wood-Cuts. One handsome volume, large 8vo. Price $1 75.

"The author of this work stands in the very front rank of scientific men, and his works upon the sciences, to which he has devoted his great powers, and his Indefatigable study, are the standard books upon those subjects. This Manual has had a very great sale in England, and its successive editions have kept pace with the steady progress of geological science. To the last edition, new and important pages have been added, containing the latest discoveries In geology. This study has never before received so great attention as at present, and in no other country can it be studied so profitably and with such practical results as in this."—Providence Journal.

"The author of this work is among the top scientists, and his writings on the sciences, to which he has dedicated his exceptional talents and tireless study, are regarded as standard texts in those fields. This Manual has sold very well in England, and its successive editions have kept up with the ongoing advancements in geological science. The latest edition includes new and significant pages that feature the most recent discoveries in geology. This field of study has never received as much attention as it does now, and no other country offers such profitable and practical opportunities for studying it."—Providence Journal.

"This is a standard work, on one of the most wonderful of modern sciences. In connection with the "Principles of Geology," by the same author, it gives a complete survey of the science at its present stage of advancement. We commend these works to the serious attention of those fossil theologians who esteem it their duty to bring the Bible, if they can, into conflict with the inductive sciences, and who think that their interpretation of Genesis is a sufficient reply to all the inductions of Geology."—Recorder.

"This is a standard work on one of the most amazing modern sciences. In conjunction with the 'Principles of Geology' by the same author, it offers a comprehensive look at the science as it stands today. We encourage these works to be seriously considered by those outdated theologians who feel it's their responsibility to pit the Bible against the empirical sciences, and who believe their interpretation of Genesis is enough to counter all the findings in Geology."—Recorder.

"The author of this volume is among the most eminent of geologists, and is well qualified to make an exposition of the science. This "Manual" is not intended as an epitome of another work, "The Principles of Geology," but occupies a distinct place, the "Principles" containing a view of the Modern changes of the Earth and its inhabitants, while the "Manual" relates to the Monuments of Ancient changes. The author recommends to the student of geology who wishes to examine his works, to commence with the "Principles," a new and thoroughly revised edition of which is just about tube issued by the Publishers of the present volume. "We are not among those who apprehend injury to the cause of Scripture truth, by the study of this science, and we only wish it were more generally and thoroughly investigated by sound minds. It is imperative on all theologians, and those designing to become such, to make this a branch, of study, and thus to be prepared to defend the truth when it is assayed, as it has been by men of science. The truth has nothing to fear, but every thing to gain even from scientific investigation."—Observer.

"The author of this book is one of the most respected geologists and is well-suited to explain the science. This "Manual" is not meant to be a summary of another work, "The Principles of Geology," but has its own unique focus. The "Principles" cover a view of the Modern changes of the Earth and its inhabitants, while the "Manual" focuses on the Monuments of Ancient changes. The author suggests that students of geology who want to explore his works should start with the "Principles," a new and thoroughly revised edition of which is about to be released by the publishers of this volume. "We do not believe that studying this science harms the cause of Scripture truth; in fact, we only wish it were more widely and rigorously explored by thoughtful individuals. It is essential for all theologians, and those planning to become one, to include this as a field of study, so they are ready to defend the truth when it is challenged, as it has been by scientists. The truth has nothing to fear but has everything to gain from scientific investigation."—Observer.


D. APPLETON & CO. HAVE JUST PUBLISHED,
A NEW AND ENLARGED EDITION OF

DR. URE'S DICTIONARY OF ARTS,

MANUFACTURES AND MINES.

Containing a clear exposition of their Principles and Practice. Illustrated with over 1600 Wood Engravings. Complete in two large 8vo. volumes of over 2000 pages. Price $5 00.

Containing a clear explanation of their principles and practices. Illustrated with more than 1600 wood engravings. Complete in two large 8vo volumes of over 2000 pages. Price $5.00.


NEW AND USEFUL WORKS.

JUST PUBLISHED BY

D. APPLETON & COMPANY

A new and much enlarged edition of

DR. URE'S

DICTIONARY OF ARTS, MANUFACTURES
AND MINES.

Containing a clear Exposition of their principles and practice. Illustrated with nearly 1,600 engravings. Complete in two large 8vo. volumes; counts over 2,000 pages. Price $5.00.

Containing a clear explanation of their principles and practices. Illustrated with nearly 1,600 engravings. Complete in two large 8vo volumes; totals over 2,000 pages. Price $5.00.

This new edition is nearly a quarter of a century in advance of any previous one.
It contains one third more matter than the latest previous one.
The statistics, inventions, and improvements, are all brought down to the present time.

This new edition is almost 25 years ahead of any previous one.
It includes one-third more content than the last edition.
The statistics, inventions, and improvements are all updated to reflect the current times.

The results of the London Exhibition on the respective subjects of which the Dictionary treats, are presented with great fulness and accurracy.

The results of the London Exhibition on the topics covered by the Dictionary are presented with great detail and accuracy.

The numerous errors in the typography of the London edition have been corrected in this.

The many mistakes in the typography of the London edition have been fixed in this one.

SIR CHARLES LYELL'S

PRINCIPLES OF GEOLOGY;

Or, the Modern Changes of the Earth and its Inhabitants, considered as illustrative of Geology. A new and much enlarged edition. Illustrated with maps, plates, and wood-cuts. 1 vol. 8vo., of 850 pages. Price $2.25.

Or, the Modern Changes of the Earth and its Inhabitants, viewed as examples of Geology. A new and significantly expanded edition. Illustrated with maps, plates, and woodcuts. 1 vol. 8vo., 850 pages. Price $2.25.

SIR CHARLES LYELL'S

MANUAL OF ELEMENTARY GEOLOGY;

Or, the Ancient Changes of the Earth and its Inhabitants, as illustrated by Geological Monuments. A new and greatly enlarged edition. Illustrated with 500 wood-cuts. 1 vol. 8vo. Price $1.75.

Or, the Ancient Changes of the Earth and its Inhabitants, as illustrated by Geological Monuments. A new and significantly expanded edition. Illustrated with 500 woodcuts. 1 vol. 8vo. Price $1.75.

*** The author of these works, stands in the very front rank of scientific men, and his works upon the science to which he has devoted his great powers and his indefatigable study, are the standard books upon these subjects.

*** The author of these works is among the leading figures in the scientific community, and his books on the field to which he has dedicated his considerable talents and tireless research are the definitive texts on these topics.

APPLETON'S

MODERN ATLAS OF THE EARTH.

With an Alphabetical Index of the Latitudes and Longitudes of 18,000 places. Thirty-four beautifully engraved and colored maps, with Temperature Scales. 4to. size, bound in 1 vol., royal 8vo. Price $3.50.

With an Alphabetical Index of the Latitudes and Longitudes of 18,000 places. Thirty-four beautifully engraved and colored maps, complete with Temperature Scales. 4to. size, bound in 1 vol., royal 8vo. Price $3.50.

This is the only complete portable Modern Atlas yet published. The maps are engraved on steel, and executed with great clearness, distinctness and accuracy. The delineations of mountainous districts, the sources of rivers and boundary lines, have been made with great care. It is designed for the table of the Student and the office of the Professional Man and is issued in a very finished and elegant style, and embraces extensive details of all the important parts of the Earth.

This is the only complete portable Modern Atlas ever published. The maps are engraved on steel and are done with great clarity, distinctness, and accuracy. The representations of mountainous areas, the origins of rivers, and boundary lines have been created with great attention to detail. It's intended for students' desks and professionals' offices, produced in a very polished and elegant style, and includes extensive details about all the significant parts of the Earth.




        
        
    
Download ePUB

If you like this ebook, consider a donation!